<?xml version="1.0" encoding="UTF-8"?>
<!DOCTYPE ThML PUBLIC 
    "-//CCEL/DTD Theological Markup Language//EN"
    "http://www.ccel.org/dtd/ThML10.dtd">
<!--
<?xml-stylesheet type="text/xml"
    href="http://www.ccel.org/ss/thml.html.xsl" ?>
<?xml-stylesheet type="text/xsl"
    href="http://www.ccel.org/ss/thml.html.xsl" ?>
-->
    
<!-- Copyright Christian Classics Ethereal Library -->
<ThML> 
<ThML.head> 

<generalInfo>
<description>
Speaking about evangelical Christianity in the 18th century without discussing
John Wesley would be like trying to drive a car without wheels. Wesley was a
pietist, preacher, and pioneer of Methodism who is known not only for his
organizational skills, but his ability to convict Christians of their need to
live a sanctified Christian life. His <i>Notes on the Bible</i> is required
reading for Methodist clergy, and a must have on the bookshelf of any Methodist
or person who desires to walk the walk of Christian life.
<br /><br />Andrew Hanson<br />CCEL Intern
</description>
<firstPublished />
<pubHistory />
<comments>This is the first version of Wesley's Notes on the Bible in ThML. Relative scripture references are not marked</comments> </generalInfo> 

<printSourceInfo>
<published /> 
</printSourceInfo> 

<electronicEdInfo>
<publisherID>ccel</publisherID>
<authorID>wesley</authorID>
<bookID>notes</bookID>
<workID>notes</workID>
<bkgID>wesleys_notes_on_the_bible_(wesley)</bkgID>
<version>1.0</version>
<series />
<editorialComments />
<revisionHistory />
<status />

<DC>
<DC.Title>Wesley's Notes on the Bible</DC.Title>
<DC.Title sub="short">Wesley's Notes</DC.Title>
<DC.Title sub="authTitle">Wesley's Notes</DC.Title>
<DC.Creator sub="Author" scheme="ccel">wesley</DC.Creator>
<DC.Creator sub="Author" scheme="file-as">Wesley, John (1703-1791)</DC.Creator>
<DC.Creator sub="Author" scheme="short-form">John Wesley</DC.Creator>
<DC.Subject scheme="CCEL">All; Bible; </DC.Subject>
<DC.Subject scheme="LCCN">BS490</DC.Subject>
<DC.Subject scheme="lcsh1">The Bible</DC.Subject>
    <DC.Subject scheme="lcsh2">Works about the Bible</DC.Subject>
    <DC.Description />
<DC.Publisher>Grand Rapids, MI: Christian Classics Ethereal
Library</DC.Publisher>
<DC.Date sub="Created" scheme="ISO8601" />
<DC.Language scheme="ISO639-3">eng</DC.Language>
<DC.Rights>Public Domain</DC.Rights>
<DC.Type>Text.Commentary</DC.Type>
<DC.Format scheme="IMT">text/xml</DC.Format>
<DC.Identifier scheme="URL">/ccel/wesley/notes.html</DC.Identifier>
</DC>
</electronicEdInfo>
</ThML.head> 

<ThML.body>

<div1 title="John Wesley's Notes on The New Testament" progress="0.01%" prev="toc" next="i.i" id="i">
<h1 id="i-p0.1">JOHN WESLEY'S NOTES</h1> 
<h1 id="i-p0.2">ON THE WHOLE BIBLE</h1> 
<h1 id="i-p0.3">THE NEW TESTAMENT</h1> 
<h2 id="i-p0.4">by John Wesley</h2>

<div2 title="PREFACE" progress="0.01%" prev="i" next="i.ii" id="i.i">
<h2 id="i.i-p0.1">PREFACE</h2> 

<p id="i.i-p1">1. For many years I have had a desire of setting down and
laying together, what has occurred to my mind, either in reading,
thinking, or conversation, which might assist serious persons, who have
not the advantage of learning, in understanding the New Testament. But I
have been continually deterred from attempting any thing of this kind,
by a deep sense of my own inability: of my want, not only of learning
for such a work, but much more, of experience and wisdom. This has often
occasioned my laying aside the thought. And when, by much importunity, I
have been prevailed upon to resume it, still I determined to delay it as
long as possible, that (if it should please God) I might finish my work
and my life together.</p>

<p id="i.i-p2">2. But having lately had a loud call from God to arise and go
hence, I am convinced that if I attempt any thing of this kind at all, I
must not delay any longer. My day is far spent, and (even in a natural
way) the shadows of the evening come on apace. And I am the rather
induced to do what little I can in this way, because I can do nothing
else: being prevented, by my present weakness, from either travelling or
preaching. But, blessed be God, I can still read, and write, and think.
O that it may be to his glory!</p>

<p id="i.i-p3">3. It will be easily discerned, even from what I have said
already, and much more from the notes themselves, that they were not
principally designed for men of learning; who are provided with many
other helps: and much less for men of long and deep experience in the
ways and word of God. I desire to sit at their feet, and to learn of
them. But I write chiefly for plain unlettered men, who understand only
their mother tongue, and yet reverence and love the word of God, and
have a desire to save their souls.</p>

<p id="i.i-p4">4. In order to assist these in such a measure as I am able, I
design first to set down the text itself, for the most part, in the
common English translation, which is, in general, (so far as I can
judge) abundantly the best that I have seen. Yet I do not say it is
incapable of being brought, in several places, nearer to the original.
Neither will I affirm, that the Greek copies from which this translation
was made, are always the most correct. And therefore I shall take the
liberty, as occasion may require, to make here and there a small
alteration.</p>

<p id="i.i-p5">5. I am very sensible this will be liable to objections: nay,
to objections of quite opposite kinds. Some will probably think, the
text is altered too much; and others, that it is altered too little. To
the former I would observe, that I never knowingly, so much as in one
place, altered it for altering sake: but there, and there only, where
first, the sense was made better, stronger, clearer, or more consistent
with the context: secondly, where the sense being equally good, the
phrase was better or nearer the original. To the latter, who think the
alterations too few, and that the translation might have been nearer
still, I answer, this is true: I acknowledge it might. But what valuable
end would it have answered, to multiply such trivial alterations as add
neither clearness nor strength to the text? This I could not prevail
upon myself to do: so much the less because there is, to my
apprehension, I know not what, peculiarly solemn and venerable in the
old language of our translation. And suppose this a mistaken
apprehension, and an instance of human infirmity; yet, is it not an
excusable infirmity, to be unwilling to part with what we have been long
accustomed to; and to love the very words by which God has often
conveyed strength or comfort to our souls!</p>

<p id="i.i-p6">6. I have endeavoured to make the notes as short as possible
that the comment may not obscure or swallow up the text: and as plain as
possible, in pursuance of my main design, to assist the unlearned
reader: for this reason I have studiously avoided, not only all curious
and critical inquiries, and all use of the learned languages, but all
such methods of reasoning and modes of expression as people in common
life are unacquainted with: for the same reason, as I rather endeavour
to obviate than to propose and answer questions, so I purposely decline
going deep into many difficulties, lest I should leave the ordinary
reader behind me.</p>

<p id="i.i-p7">7. I once designed to write down barely what occurred, to my
own mind, consulting none but the inspired writers. But no sooner was I
acquainted with that great light of the Christian world, (lately gone to
his reward, ) Bengelius, than I entirely changed my design, being
thoroughly convinced it might be of more service to the cause of
religion, were I barely to translate his Gnomon Novi Testamenti, than to
write many volumes upon it. Many of his excellent notes I have therefore
translated. Many more I have abridged, omitting that part which was
purely critical, and giving the substance of the rest. Those various
readings likewise, which he has showed to have a vast majority of
ancient copies and translations on their side, I have without scruple
incorporated with the text; which, after his manner, I have divided all
along (though not omitting the common division into chapters and verses,
which is of use on various accounts) according to the matter it
contains, making a larger or smaller pause, just as the sense requires.
And even this is such a help in many places, as one who has not tried it
can scarcely conceive.</p>

<p id="i.i-p8">8. I am likewise indebted for some useful observations to Dr.
Heylin's Theological Lectures: and for many more to Dr. Guyse, and to
the Family Expositor of the late pious and learned Dr. Doddridge. It was
a doubt with me for some time, whether I should not subjoin to every
note I received from them the name of the author from whom it was taken;
especially considering I had transcribed some, and abridged many more,
almost in the words of the author. But upon further consideration, I
resolved to name none, that nothing might divert the mind of the reader
from keeping close to the point in view, and receiving what was spoken
only according to its own intrinsic value.</p>

<p id="i.i-p9">9. I cannot flatter myself so far (to use the words of one of
the above-named writers) as to imagine that I have fallen into no
mistakes in a work of so great difficulty. But my own conscience acquits
me of having designedly misrepresented any single passage of Scripture,
or of having written one line with a purpose of inflaming the hearts of
Christians against each other. God forbid that I should make the words
of the most gentle and benevolent Jesus a vehicle to convey such poison.
Would to God that all the party names, and unscriptural phrases and
forms, which have divided the Christian world, were forgot: and that we
might all agree to sit down together, as humble, loving disciples, at
the feet of our common Master, to hear his word, to imbibe his Spirit,
and to transcribe his life in our own!</p>

<p id="i.i-p10">10. Concerning the Scriptures in general, it may be observed,
the word of the living God, which directed the first patriarchs also,
was, in the time of Moses, committed to writing. To this were added, in
several succeeding generations, the inspired writings of the other
prophets. Afterward, what the Son of God preached, and the Holy Ghost
spake by the apostles, the apostles and evangelists wrote. - This is
what we now style the Holy Scripture: this is that word of God which
remaineth forever: of which, though heaven and earth pass away, one jot
or tittle shall not pass away. The Scripture therefore of the Old and
New Testament is a most solid and precious system of Divine truth.
Every part thereof is worthy of God; and all together are one entire
body, wherein is no defect, no excess. It is the fountain of heavenly
wisdom, which they who are able to taste, prefer to all writings of men,
however wise, or learned, or holy.</p>

<p id="i.i-p11">11. An exact knowledge of the truth was accompanied in the
inspired writers with an exactly regular series of arguments, a precise
expression of their meaning, and a genuine vigour of suitable
affections. The chain of argument in each book is briefly exhibited in
the table prefixed to it, which contains also the sum thereof, and may
be of more use than prefixing the argument to each chapter; the division
of the New Testament into chapters having been made in the dark ages,
and very incorrectly; often separating things that are closely joined,
and joining those that are entirely distinct from each other.</p>

<p id="i.i-p12">12. In the language of the sacred writings, we may observe
the utmost depth, together with the utmost ease. All the elegancies of
human composures sink into nothing before it: God speaks not as man, but
as God. His thoughts are very deep: and thence his words are of
inexhaustible virtue. And the language of his messengers also is exact
in the highest degree: for the words which were given them accurately
answered the impression made upon their minds: and hence Luther says,
"Divinity is nothing but a grammar of the language of the Holy Ghost."
To understand this thoroughly, we should observe the emphasis which lies
on every word; the holy affections expressed thereby, and the tempers
shown by every writer. But how little are these, the latter especially,
regarded? Though they are wonderfully diffused through the whole New
Testament, and are in truth a continued commendation of him who acts, or
speaks, or writes.</p>

<p id="i.i-p13">13. The New Testament is all those sacred writings in which
the New Testament or covenant is described. The former part of this
contains the writings of the evangelists and apostles: the latter, the
Revelation of Jesus Christ. In the former is, first, the history of
Jesus Christ, from his coming in the flesh to his ascension into heaven;
then the institution and history of the Christian Church, from the time
of his ascension. The Revelation delivers what is to be, with regard to
Christ, the Church, and the universe, till the consummation of all
things. BRISTOL HOT-WELLS, January 4, 1754.</p>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE GOSPEL ACCORDING TO ST. MATTHEW" progress="0.18%" prev="i.i" next="i.ii.i" id="i.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt" id="i.ii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.ii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE GOSPEL ACCORDING TO ST. MATTHEW</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Matthew" progress="0.19%" prev="i.ii" next="i.ii.ii" id="i.ii.i">

<p id="i.ii.i-p1">THE Gospel (that is, good tidings) means a book containing
the good tidings of our salvation by Jesus Christ. St. Mark in his
Gospel presupposes that of St. Matthew, and supplies what is omitted
therein. St. Luke supplies what is omitted by both the former: St. John
what is omitted by all the three. St. Matthew particularly points out
the fulfilling of the prophecies for the conviction of the Jews. St.
Mark wrote a short compendium, and yet added many remarkable
circumstances omitted by St. Matthew, particularly with regard to the
apostles, immediately after they were called. St. Luke treated
principally of the office of Christ, and mostly in a historical manner.
St. John refuted those who denied his Godhead: each choosing to treat
more largely on those things, which most suited the time when, and the
persons to whom, he wrote.</p>

<p id="i.ii.i-p2">The Gospel according to St. Matthew contains,</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.ii.i-p3">I. The birth of Christ, and what presently
followed it</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p4">a. His genealogy Chap i. 1-17</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p5">b. His birth 18-25</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p6">c. The coming of the wise men ii, 1-12</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p7">d. His flight into Egypt, and return 13-23
</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.ii.i-p8">II. The introduction</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p9">a. John the Baptist iii, 1-12</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p10">b. The baptism of Christ 13-17</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p11">c. His temptation and victory iv, 1-11</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.ii.i-p12">III. The actions and words by which Jesus
proved he was the Christ</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p13">a. At Capernaum 12-16</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p14">Where we may observe</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p15">1. His preaching 17</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p16">2. Calling Andrew and Peter, James and <scripRef passage="John 18" id="i.ii.i-p16.1" parsed="|John|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18">John
18</scripRef>-22</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p17">3. Preaching and healing, 23-25</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p18">4. Sermon on the mount v, vi, vii</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p19">5. Healing the leper viii, 1-4</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p20">6. The centurion's servant 5-13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p21">7. Peter's mother-in-law 14-15</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p22">8. Many that were sick 16-17</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p23">b. In his journey (wherein he admonished two
that offered to follow him) over the sea. Here we may observe</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p24">1. His dominion over the winds and seas 18-27
</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p25">2. The devils passing from the men into the
swine 28-34</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p26">c. At Capernaum again Here, ix,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p27">1. He cures the paralytic 1-8</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p28">2. Calls Matthew, and defends his conversing
with publicans and sinners 9-13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p29">3. Answers concerning fasting 14-17</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p30">4. Raises Jairus's daughter (after curing the
issue of blood). 18-26</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p31">5. Gives sight to two blind men 27-31</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p32">6. Dispossesses the demoniac 32-34</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p33">7. Goes through the cities, and directs to
pray for labourers. 35-38</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p34">8. Sends and instructs labourers, and
preaches himself. x, 1; xi, 1</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p35">9. Answers the message of <scripRef passage="John 2" id="i.ii.i-p35.1" parsed="|John|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.2">John 2</scripRef>-6</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p36">10. Commends John, reproves the unbelieving
cities, invites the weary 7-30</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p37">11. Defends the disciples' plucking the corn
Chap. xii, 1-8</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p38">12. Heals the withered hand 9-13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p39">13. Retires from the Pharisees lying in wait
14-21</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p40">14. Cures the demoniac, while the people
wonder, and the Pharisees blaspheming, are refuted 22-37</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p41">15. Reproves them that require a sign 38-45
</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p42">16. Declares who are his relations, and 46-50
</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p43">17. Teaches by parables xiii, 1-52</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p44">d. At Nazareth 53-58</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p45">e. In other places</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p46">1. Herod having killed John, doubts
concerning Jesus. Jesus retiring, is sought for by the people xiv, 1-13
</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p47">2. He heals the sick, and feeds five thousand
14-21</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p48">3. His voyage and miracles in the land of
Gennesaret 22-36</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p49">4. Unwashen hands xv, 1-20</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p50">5. The woman of Canaan 21-28</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p51">6. Many sick healed 29-31</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p52">7. Four thousand fed 32-38</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p53">8. Those who require a sign reproved xv, 39;
xvi, 1-4</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p54">9. The leaven of the Pharisees 5-12</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.ii.i-p55">IV. Predictions of his death and resurrection
</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p56">a. The first prediction</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p57">1. Preparation for it by a confirmation that
he is the Christ. 13-20</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p58">2. The prediction itself, and reproof of
Peter 21-28</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p59">b. The second prediction</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p60">1. The transfiguration, and silence enjoined
xvii, 1-13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p61">2. The lunatic healed 14-21</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p62">3. The prediction itself 22-23</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p63">4. The tribute paid 24-27</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p64">5. Who is greatest in Christ's kingdom xviii,
1-20</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p65">6. The duty of forgiving our brother 21-35
</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p66">c. The third prediction</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p67">1. Jesus departs out of Galilee xix, 1-2</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p68">2 Of divorce and celibacy 3-12</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p69">3. His tenderness to little children 13-15
</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p70">4. The rich man drawing back, and hence 16-22
Of the salvation of the rich 23-26 Of the reward of following Christ
27-30 Of the last and the first xx, 1-16</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p71">5. The prediction itself 17-19</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p72">6. The request of James and John; humility
enjoined 20-28</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p73">7. The two blind men cured 29-34</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.ii.i-p74">V. Transactions at Jerusalem before his
passion</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p75">a. Sunday His royal entry into Jerusalem xxi,
1-11 His purging the temple 12-17</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p76">b. Monday The barren fig tree 18-22</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p77">c. Tuesday, transactions In the temple</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p78">1. The chief priests and elders confuted By a
question concerning John's baptism 23-27 By the parables Of the two sons
28-32 Of the vineyard 33-44</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p79">2. Seek to lay hands on him 45-46</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p80">3. The parable of the marriage feast xxii,
1-14</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p81">4. He is questioned, concerning paying
tribute 15-22 The resurrection 23-33 The great commandment 34-40</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p82">5. Christ's question concerning David's Lord
41-46 Caution concerning the scribes and Pharisees xxiii, 1-12 Severe
reproof of them 13-36 and of Jerusalem 37-39 Out of the temple:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p83">1. His discourse of the destruction of
Jerusalem, and the end of the world Chap. xxiv, 1-51</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p84">2. The ten virgins, the talents; the last
judgment . xxv, 1-46</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.ii.i-p85">VI. His passion and resurrection</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p86">A. His passion, death, and burial xxvi, 1-2
</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p87">a. Wednesday His prediction xxvi, 1-2 The
consultation of the chief priests and elders 3-5 Judas bargains to
betray him 6-16</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p88">b. Thursday</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p89">1. In the day time The passover prepared
17-19</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p90">2. In the evening The traitor discovered
20-25 The Lord's Supper 26-29</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p91">3. In the night</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p92">1. Jesus foretells the cowardice of the
apostles 33-35</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p93">2. Is in agony 36-46</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p94">3. Is apprehended, reproves Peter and the
multitude; is forsaken of all 47-56</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p95">4. Is led to Caiaphas, falsely accused, owns
himself the Son of God, is condemned, derided 57-68</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p96">5. Peter denies him and weeps 69-75</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p97">c. Friday</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p98">1. The height of his passion In the morning
</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p99">1. Jesus is delivered to Pilate xxvii, 1-2
</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p100">2. The death of Judas 3-10</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p101">3. Jesus's kingdom and silence 11-14</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p102">4. Pilate, though warned by his wife,
condemns him 15-26</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p103">5. He is mocked and led forth 27-32 The third
hour The vinegar and gall: the crucifixion; his garments divided; the
inscription on the cross; the two robbers; blasphemies 33-44 From the
sixth to the ninth hour The darkness, his last agony 45-49</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p104">2. His death 50 The veil rent, and a great
earthquake 51-53 The centurion wonders; the women behold 54-56</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p105">3. His burial 57-61</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.i-p106">d. Saturday The sepulchre secured 62-66</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ii.i-p107">B. His resurrection</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p108">1. Testified to the women by an angel xxviii,
1-8 By our Lord himself 9-10</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p109">2. Denied by his adversaries 11-15</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.i-p110">1. Proved to his apostles 16-20</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="ST. MATTHEW" progress="0.30%" prev="i.ii.i" next="i.ii.iii" id="i.ii.ii">
<h3 id="i.ii.ii-p0.1">ST. MATTHEW</h3> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="0.30%" prev="i.ii.ii" next="i.ii.iv" id="i.ii.iii">
<h3 id="i.ii.iii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. i" id="i.ii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.1" /> 

<p id="i.ii.iii-p1">1. The book of the generation of Jesus Christ -- that is,
strictly speaking, the account of his birth and genealogy. This title
therefore properly relates to the verses that immediately follow: but as
it sometimes signifies the history of a person, in that sense it may
belong to the whole book. If there were any difficulties in this
genealogy, or that given by St. Luke, which could not easily be removed,
they would rather affect the Jewish tables, than the credit of the
evangelists: for they act only as historians setting down these
genealogies, as they stood in those public and allowed records.
Therefore they were to take them as they found them. Nor was it needful
they should correct the mistakes, if there were any. For these accounts
sufficiently answer the end for which they are recited. They
unquestionably prove the grand point in view, that Jesus was of the
family from which the promised seed was to come. And they had more
weight with the Jews for this purpose, than if alterations had been made
by inspiration itself. For such alterations would have occasioned
endless disputes between them and the disciples of our Lord. The son of
David, the son of Abraham - He is so called, because to these he was
more peculiarly promised; and of these it was often foretold the Messiah
should spring. <scripRef passage="Luke iii. 31" id="i.ii.iii-p1.1" parsed="|Luke|3|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3.31">Luke iii, 31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p2">3. Of Thamar - St. Matthew adds the names of those women
also, that were remarkable in the sacred history.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p3">4. Naasson -- who was prince of the tribe of Judah, when the
Israelites entered into Canaan.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p4">5. Obed begat Jesse -- the providence of God was peculiarly
shown in this, that Salmon, Boaz, and Obed, must each of them have been
near a hundred years old, at the birth of his son here recorded.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p5">6. David the king -- particularly mentioned under this
character, because his throne is given to the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p6">8. Jehoram begat Uzziah - Jehoahaz, Joash, and Amaziah
coming between. So that he begat him mediately, as Christ is mediately
the son of David and of Abraham. So the progeny of Hezekiah, after many
generations, are called the sons that should issue from him, which he
should beget, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxxix. 7" id="i.ii.iii-p6.1" parsed="|Isa|39|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.39.7">Isaiah xxxix,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p7">11. Josiah begat Jeconiah -- mediately, Jehoiakim coming
between. And his brethren - That is, his uncles. The Jews term all

kinsmen brethren. About the time they were carried away -- which was a
little after the birth of Jeconiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p8">16. The husband of Mary - Jesus was generally believed to
be the son of Joseph. It was needful for all who believed this, to know,
that Joseph was sprung from David. Otherwise they would not allow Jesus
to be the Christ. Jesus, who is called Christ - The name Jesus respects
chiefly the promise of blessing made to Abraham: the name Christ, the
promise of the Messiah's kingdom, which was made to David. It may be
further observed, that the word Christ in Greek, and Messiah in Hebrews,
signify anointed, and imply the prophetic, priestly, and royal
characters, which were to meet in the Messiah. Among the Jews, anointing
was the ceremony whereby prophets, priests, and kings were initiated
into those offices. And if we look into ourselves, we shall find a want
of Christ in all these respects. We are by nature at a distance from
God, alienated from him, and incapable of a free access to him. Hence we
want a mediator, an intercessor, in a word, a Christ, in his priestly
office. This regards our state with respect to God. And with respect to
ourselves, we find a total darkness, blindness, ignorance of God, and
the things of God. Now here we want Christ in his prophetic office, to
enlighten our minds, and teach us the whole will of God. We find also
within us a strange misrule of appetites and passions. For these we want
Christ in his royal character, to reign in our hearts, and subdue all
things to himself.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p9">17. So all the generations -- observe, in order to complete
the three fourteens, David ends the first fourteen, and begins the
second (which reaches to the captivity) and Jesus ends the third
fourteen. When we survey such a series of generations, it is a natural
and obvious reflection, how like the leaves of a tree one passeth away,
and another cometh! Yet the earth still abideth. And with it the
goodness of the Lord which runs from generation to generation, the
common hope of parents and children. Of those who formerly lived upon
earth, and perhaps made the most conspicuous figure, how many are there
whose names are perished with them? How many, of whom only the names are
remaining? Thus are we likewise passing away! And thus shall we shortly
be forgotten! Happy are we, if, while we are forgotten by men, we are
remembered by God! If our names, lost on earth, are at length found
written in the book of life!</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p10">19. A just man -- a strict observer of the law: therefore
not thinking it right to keep her.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p11">21. Jesus - That is, a Saviour. It is the same name with
Joshua (who was a type of him) which properly signifies, The Lord,
Salvation. His people - Israel. And all the Israel of God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p12">23. They shall call his name Emmanuel -- to be called, only
means, according to the Hebrews manner of speaking, that the person
spoken of shall really and effectually be what he is called, and
actually fulfil that title. Thus, Unto us a child is born - and his name
shall be called Wonderful, Counsellor, the Mighty God, the Prince of
Peace -- that is, he shall be all these, though not so much nominally, as
really, and in effect. And thus was he called Emmanuel; which was no
common name of Christ, but points out his nature and office; as he is
God incarnate, and dwells by his Spirit in the hearts of his people. It
is observable, the words in Isaiah are, Thou (namely, his mother) shalt
call; but here, They - that is, all his people, shall call - shall
acknowledge him to be Emmanuel, God with us. Which being interpreted --
this is a clear proof that St. Matthew wrote his Gospel in Greek, and
not in Hebrew. <scripRef passage="Isaiah vii. 14" id="i.ii.iii-p12.1" parsed="|Isa|7|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.7.14">Isaiah vii,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iii-p13">25. He knew her not, till after she had brought forth. It
cannot be inferred from hence, that he knew her afterward: no more than
it can be inferred from that expression, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. vi. 23" id="i.ii.iii-p13.1" parsed="|2Sam|6|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.6.23">2 Sam. vi, 23</scripRef>, Michal had no child till the day of her death, that she had
children afterward. Nor do the words that follow, the first-born son,
alter the case. For there are abundance of places, wherein the term
first born is used, though there were no subsequent children. <scripRef passage="Luke ii. 7" id="i.ii.iii-p13.2" parsed="|Luke|2|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.2.7">Luke
ii, 7</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="0.41%" prev="i.ii.iii" next="i.ii.v" id="i.ii.iv">
<h3 id="i.ii.iv-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. ii" id="i.ii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.2" /> 

<p id="i.ii.iv-p1">1. Bethlehem of Judea - There was another Bethlehem in the
tribe of Zebulon. In the days of Herod - commonly called Herod the
Great, born at Ascalon. The scepter was now on the point of departing
from Judah. Among his sons were Archelaus, mentioned ver. 22; Herod
Antipas, mentioned chap. xiv, and Philip, mentioned <scripRef passage="Luke iii. 19" id="i.ii.iv-p1.1" parsed="|Luke|3|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3.19">Luke iii, 19</scripRef>. Herod Agrippa, mentioned <scripRef passage="Acts xii. 1" id="i.ii.iv-p1.2" parsed="|Acts|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.12.1">Acts xii, 1</scripRef>; &amp;c., was his grandson. Wise men - The first fruits of
the Gentiles. Probably they were Gentile philosophers, who, through the
Divine assistance, had improved their knowledge of nature, as a means of
leading to the knowledge of the one true God. Nor is it unreasonable to
suppose, that God had favoured them with some extraordinary Revelations
of himself, as he did Melchisedec, Job, and several others, who were not
of the family of Abraham; to which he never intended absolutely to
confine his favours. The title given them in the original was anciently
given to all philosophers, or men of learning; those particularly who
were curious in examining the works of nature, and observing the motions
of the heavenly bodies. From the east - So Arabia is frequently called
in Scripture. It lay to the east of Judea, and was famous for gold,
frankincense, and myrrh. We have seen his star - Undoubtedly they had
before heard Balaam's prophecy. And probably when they saw this unusual
star, it was revealed to them that this prophecy was fulfilled. In the
east - That is, while we were in the east.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p2">2. To do him homage - To pay him that honour, by bowing to
the earth before him, which the eastern nations used to pay to their
monarchs.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p3">4. The chief priests - That is, not only the high priest
and his deputy, with those who formerly had born that office: but also
the chief man in each of those twenty-four courses, into which the body
of priests were divided, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xxiv. 6-19" id="i.ii.iv-p3.1" parsed="|1Chr|24|6|24|19" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.24.6-1Chr.24.19">1
Chron. xxiv, 6-19</scripRef>. The scribes were those whose peculiar business it was to
explain the Scriptures to the people. They were the public preachers, or
expounders of the law of Moses. Whence the chief of them were called
doctors of the law.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p4">6. Thou art in nowise the least among the princes of Judah
- That is, among the cities belonging to the princes or heads of
thousands in Judah. When this and several other quotations from the Old
Testament are compared with the original, it plainly appears, the
apostles did not always think it necessary exactly to transcribe the
passages they cited, but contented themselves with giving the general
sense, though with some diversity of language. The words of Micah, which
we render, Though thou be little, may be rendered, Art thou little? And
then the difference which seems to be here between the prophet and the
evangelist vanishes away. <scripRef passage="Micah v. 2" id="i.ii.iv-p4.1" parsed="|Mic|5|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mic.5.2">Micah v,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p5">8. And if ye find him, bring me word - Probably Herod did
not believe he was born; otherwise would not so suspicious a prince have
tried to make sure work at once?</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p6">10. Seeing the star - Standing over where the child was.
</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p7">11. They presented to him gifts - It was customary to offer
some present to any eminent person whom they visited. And so it is, as
travelers observe, in the eastern countries to this day. Gold,
frankincense, and myrrh - Probably these were the best things their
country afforded; and the presents ordinarily made to great persons.
This was a most seasonable, providential assistance for a long and
expensive journey into Egypt, a country where they were entirely
strangers, and were to stay for a considerable time.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p8">15. That it might be fulfilled - That is, whereby was
fulfilled. The original word frequently signifies, not the design of an
action, but barely the consequence or event of it. Which was spoken of
the Lord by the prophet - on another occasion: Out of Egypt have I
called my Son - which was now fulfilled as it were anew; Christ being in
a far higher sense the Son of God than Israel, of whom the words were
originally spoken. <scripRef passage="Hosea xi. 1" id="i.ii.iv-p8.1" parsed="|Hos|11|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.11.1">Hosea xi,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p9">16. Then Herod, seeing that he was deluded by the wise men
- So did his pride teach him to regard this action, as if it were
intended to expose him to the derision of his subjects. Sending forth -
a party of soldiers: In all the confines thereof - In all the
neighbouring places, of which Rama was one.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p10">17. Then was fulfilled - A passage of Scripture, whether
prophetic, historical, or poetical, is in the language of the New
Testament fulfilled, when an event happens to which it may with great
propriety be accommodated.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p11">18. Rachel weeping for her children - The Benjamites, who
inhabited Rama, sprung from her. She was buried near this place; and is
here beautifully represented risen, as it were out of her grave, and
bewailing her lost children. Because they are not - that is, are dead.
The preservation of Jesus from this destruction, may be considered as a
figure of God's care over his children in their greatest danger. God
does not often, as he easily could, cut off their persecutors at a
stroke. But he provides a hiding place for his people, and by methods
not less effectual, though less pompous, preserves them from being swept
away, even when the enemy comes in like a flood. <scripRef passage="Jer. xxxi. 15" id="i.ii.iv-p11.1" parsed="|Jer|31|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.31.15">Jer. xxxi, 15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p12">22. He was afraid to go thither - into Judea; and so turned
aside into the region of Galilee - a part of the land of Israel not
under the jurisdiction of Archelaus.</p>

<p id="i.ii.iv-p13">23. He came and dwelt in Nazareth - (where he had dwelt
before he went to Bethlehem) a place contemptible to a proverb. So that
hereby was fulfilled what has been spoken in effect by several of the
prophets, (though by none of them in express words, ) He shall be called
a Nazarene - that is, he shall be despised and rejected, shall be a mark
of public contempt and reproach.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="0.51%" prev="i.ii.iv" next="i.ii.vi" id="i.ii.v">
<h3 id="i.ii.v-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. iii" id="i.ii.v-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.3" /> 

<p id="i.ii.v-p1">1. In those days - that is, while Jesus dwelt there. In the
wilderness of Judea - This was a wilderness properly so called, a wild,
barren, desolate place as was that also where our Lord was tempted. But,
generally speaking, a wilderness in the New Testament means only a
common, or less cultivated place, in opposition to pasture and arable
land. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 1" id="i.ii.v-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.1">Mark i, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iii. 1" id="i.ii.v-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3.1">Luke iii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p2">2. The kingdom of heaven, and the kingdom of God, are but
two phrases for the same thing. They mean, not barely a future happy
state, in heaven, but a state to be enjoyed on earth: the proper
disposition for the glory of heaven, rather than the possession of it.
Is at hand - As if he had said, God is about to erect that kingdom,
spoken of by Daniel, <scripRef passage="Dan. ii. 44; vii. 13, 14" id="i.ii.v-p2.1" parsed="|Dan|2|44|0|0;|Dan|7|13|7|14" osisRef="Bible:Dan.2.44 Bible:Dan.7.13-Dan.7.14">Dan.
ii, 44; vii, 13, 14</scripRef>; the kingdom of the God of heaven. It properly signifies
here, the Gospel dispensation, in which subjects were to be gathered to
God by his Son, and a society to be formed, which was to subsist first
on earth, and afterward with God in glory. In some places of Scripture,
the phrase more particularly denotes the state of it on earth: in,
others, it signifies only the state of glory: but it generally includes
both. The Jews understood it of a temporal kingdom, the seat of which
they supposed would be Jerusalem; and the expected sovereign of this
kingdom they learned from Daniel to call the Son of man. Both John the
Baptist and Christ took up that phrase, the kingdom of heaven, as they
found it, and gradually taught the Jews (though greatly unwilling to
learn) to understand it right. The very demand of repentance, as
previous to it, showed it was a spiritual kingdom, and that no wicked
man, how politic, brave, or learned soever, could possibly be a subject
of it.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p3">3. The way of the Lord - Of Christ. Make his paths straight
- By removing every thing which might prove a hindrance to his gracious
appearance. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 3" id="i.ii.v-p3.1" parsed="|Isa|40|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.3">Isaiah xl, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p4">4. John had his raiment of camel's hair - Coarse and rough,
suiting his character and doctrine. A leathern girdle - Like Elijah, in
whose spirit and power he came. His food was locusts and wild honey -
Locusts are ranked among clean meats, <scripRef passage="Lev. xi. 22" id="i.ii.v-p4.1" parsed="|Lev|11|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.11.22">Lev. xi, 22</scripRef>. But these were not always to be had. So in default of
those, he fed on wild honey.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p5">6. Confessing their sins - Of their own accord; freely and
openly. Such prodigious numbers could hardly be baptized by immerging
their whole bodies under water: nor can we think they were provided with
change of raiment for it, which was scarcely practicable for such vast
multitudes. And yet they could not be immerged naked with modesty, nor
in their wearing apparel with safety. It seems, therefore, that they
stood in ranks on the edge of the river, and that John, passing along
before them, cast water on their heads or faces, by which means he might
baptize many thousands in a day. And this way most naturally signified
Christ's baptizing them with the Holy Ghost and with fire, which John
spoke of, as prefigured by his baptizing with water, and which was
eminently fulfilled, when the Holy Ghost sat upon the disciples in the
appearance of tongues, or flames of fire.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p6">7. The Pharisees were a very ancient sect among the Jews.
They took their name from a Hebrew word, which signifies to separate,
because they separated themselves from all other men. They were
outwardly strict observers of the law, fasted often, made long prayers,
rigorously kept the Sabbath, and paid all tithe, even of mint, anise,
and cummin. Hence they were in high esteem among the people. But
inwardly, they were full of pride and hypocrisy. The Sadducees were
another sect among the Jews, only not so considerable as the Pharisees.
They denied the existence of angels, and the immortality of the soul,
and by consequence the resurrection of the dead. Ye brood of vipers - In
like manner, the crafty Herod is styled a fox, and persons of insidious,
ravenous, profane, or sensual dispositions, are named respectively by
him who saw their hearts, serpents, dogs, wolves, and swine; terms which
are not the random language of passion, but a judicious designation of
the persons meant by them. For it was fitting such men should be marked
out, either for a caution to others, or a warning to themselves.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p7">8. Repentance is of two sorts; that which is termed legal,
and that which is styled evangelical repentance. The former (which is
the same that is spoken of here) is a thorough conviction of sin. The
latter is a change of heart (and consequently of life) from all sin to
all holiness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p8">9. And say not confidently - The word in the original,
vulgarly rendered, Think not, seems here, and in many places, not to
diminish, but rather add to the force of the word with which it is
joined. We have Abraham to our father - It is almost incredible, how
great the presumption of the Jews was on this their relation to Abraham.
One of their famous sayings was, "Abraham sits near the gates of hell,
and suffers no Israelite to go down into it." I say unto you - This
preface always denotes the importance of what follows. Of these stones -
Probably pointing to those which lay before them.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p9">10. But the axe also already lieth - That is, there is no
room for such idle pretenses. Speedy execution is determined against all
that do not repent. The comparison seems to be taken from a woodman that
has laid down his axe to put off his coat, and then immediately goes to
work to cut down the tree. This refers to the wrath to come in verse 7.
Is hewn down - Instantly, without farther delay.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p10">11. He shall baptize you with the Holy Ghost and with fire
- He shall fill you with the Holy Ghost, inflaming your hearts with that
fire of love, which many waters cannot quench. And this was done, even
with a visible appearance as of fire, on the day of pentecost.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p11">12. Whose fan - That is, the word of the Gospel. His floor
- That is, his Church, which is now covered with a mixture of wheat and
chaff. He will gather the wheat into the garner - Will lay up those who
are truly good in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p12">13. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 9" id="i.ii.v-p12.1" parsed="|Mark|1|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.9">Mark i, 9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iii. 21" id="i.ii.v-p12.2" parsed="|Luke|3|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3.21">Luke iii, 21</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p13">15. It becometh us to fulfil all righteousness - It
becometh every messenger of God to observe all his righteous ordinances.
But the particular meaning of our Lord seems to be, that it becometh us
to do (me to receive baptism, and you to administer it) in order to
fulfil, that is, that I may fully perform every part of the righteous
law of God, and the commission he hath given me.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p14">16. And Jesus being baptized - Let our Lord's submitting to
baptism teach us a holy exactness in the observance of those
institutions which owe their obligation merely to a Divine command.
Surely thus it becometh all his followers to fulfil all righteousness.
Jesus had no sin to wash away. And yet he was baptized. And God owned
his ordinance, so as to make it the season of pouring forth the Holy
Spirit upon him. And where can we expect this sacred effusion, but in an
humble attendance on Divine appointments? Lo, the heavens were opened,
and he saw the Spirit of God - St. Luke adds, in a bodily form -
Probably in a glorious appearance of fire, perhaps in the shape of a
dove, descending with a hovering motion, till it rested upon him. This
was a visible token of those secret operations of the blessed Spirit, by
which he was anointed in a peculiar manner; and abundantly fitted for
his public work.</p>

<p id="i.ii.v-p15">17. And lo, a voice - We have here a glorious manifestation
of the ever - blessed Trinity: the Father speaking from heaven, the Son
spoken to, the Holy Ghost descending upon him. In whom I delight - What
an encomium is this! How poor to this are all other kinds of praise! To
be the pleasure, the delight of God, this is praise indeed: this is true
glory: this is the highest, the brightest light, that virtue can appear
in.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="0.65%" prev="i.ii.v" next="i.ii.vii" id="i.ii.vi">
<h3 id="i.ii.vi-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. iv" id="i.ii.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4" /> 

<p id="i.ii.vi-p1">1. Then - After this glorious evidence of his Father's
love, he was completely armed for the combat. Thus after the clearest
light and the strongest consolation, let us expect the sharpest
temptations. By the Spirit - Probably through a strong inward impulse. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 12" id="i.ii.vi-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|1|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.12">Mark i, 12</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 1" id="i.ii.vi-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|4|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.1">Luke iv,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p2">2. Having fasted - Whereby doubtless he received more
abundant spiritual strength from God. Forty days and forty nights - As
did Moses, the giver of the law, and Elijah, the great restorer of it.
He was afterward hungry - And so prepared for the first temptation.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p3">3. Coming to him - In a visible form; probably in a human
shape, as one that desired to inquire further into the evidences of his
being the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p4">4. It is written - Thus Christ answered, and thus we may
answer all the suggestions of the devil. By every word that proceedeth
out of the mouth of God - That is, by whatever God commands to sustain
him. Therefore it is not needful I should work a miracle to procure
bread, without any intimation of my Father's will. <scripRef passage="Deut. viii. 3" id="i.ii.vi-p4.1" parsed="|Deut|8|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.8.3">Deut. viii, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p5">5. The holy city - So Jerusalem was commonly called, being
the place God had peculiarly chosen for himself. On the battlement of
the temple - Probably over the king's gallery, which was of such a
prodigious height, that no one could look down from the top of it
without making himself giddy.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p6">6. In their hands - That is, with great care. <scripRef passage="Psalm xci. 11, 12" id="i.ii.vi-p6.1" parsed="|Ps|91|11|91|12" osisRef="Bible:Ps.91.11-Ps.91.12">Psalm xci, 11, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p7">7. Thou shalt not tempt the Lord thy God - By requiring
farther evidence of what he hath already made sufficiently plain. <scripRef passage="Deut. vi. 16" id="i.ii.vi-p7.1" parsed="|Deut|6|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.6.16">Deut. vi, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p8">8. Showeth him all the kingdoms of the world - In a kind of
visionary representation.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p9">9. If thou wilt fall down and worship me - Here Satan
clearly shows who he was. Accordingly Christ answering this suggestion,
calls him by his own name, which he had not done before.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p10">10. Get thee hence, Satan - Not, get thee behind me, that
is, into thy proper place; as he said on a quite different occasion to
Peter, speaking what was not expedient. <scripRef passage="Deut. vi. 13" id="i.ii.vi-p10.1" parsed="|Deut|6|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.6.13">Deut. vi, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p11">11. Angels came and waited upon him - Both to supply him
with food, and to congratulate his victory.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p12">12. He retired into Galilee - This journey was not
immediately after his temptation. He first went from Judea into Galilee,
<scripRef passage="John i. 43; ii. 1" id="i.ii.vi-p12.1" parsed="|John|1|43|0|0;|John|2|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.43 Bible:John.2.1">John i, 43; ii, 1</scripRef>. Then into Judea again, and celebrated the passover at
Jerusalem, <scripRef passage="John ii. 13" id="i.ii.vi-p12.2" parsed="|John|2|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.2.13">John ii, 13</scripRef>. He baptized in Judea while John was baptizing at Enon, <scripRef passage="John iii. 22, 23" id="i.ii.vi-p12.3" parsed="|John|3|22|3|23" osisRef="Bible:John.3.22-John.3.23">John
iii, 22, 23</scripRef>. All this time John was at liberty, <scripRef passage="John iii. 24" id="i.ii.vi-p12.4" parsed="|John|3|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.3.24">John iii, 24</scripRef>. But the Pharisees being offended, <scripRef passage="John iv. 1" id="i.ii.vi-p12.5" parsed="|John|4|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.4.1">John iv,
1</scripRef>; and John put in prison, he then took this journey into
Galilee. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 14" id="i.ii.vi-p12.6" parsed="|Mark|1|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.14">Mark i, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p13">13. Leaving Nazareth - Namely, when they had wholly
rejected his word, and even attempted to kill him, <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 29" id="i.ii.vi-p13.1" parsed="|Luke|4|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.29">Luke iv, 29</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p14">15. Galilee of the Gentiles - That part of Galilee which
lay beyond Jordan was so called, because it was in a great measure
inhabited by Gentiles, that is, heathens. <scripRef passage="Isaiah ix. 1, 2" id="i.ii.vi-p14.1" parsed="|Isa|9|1|9|2" osisRef="Bible:Isa.9.1-Isa.9.2">Isaiah ix, 1, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p15">16. Here is a beautiful gradation, first, they walked, then
they sat in darkness, and lastly, in the region of the shadow of death.
</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p16">17. From that time Jesus began to preach - He had preached
before, both to Jews and Samaritans, <scripRef passage="John iv. 41, 45" id="i.ii.vi-p16.1" parsed="|John|4|41|0|0;|John|4|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.4.41 Bible:John.4.45">John iv, 41, 45</scripRef>. But from this time begin his solemn stated preaching.
Repent, for the kingdom of heaven is at hand - Although it is the
peculiar business of Christ to establish the kingdom of heaven in the
hearts of men, yet it is observable, he begins his preaching in the same
words with John the Baptist: because the repentance which John taught
still was, and ever will be, the necessary preparation for that inward
kingdom. But that phrase is not only used with regard to individuals in
whom it is to be established, but also with regard to the Christian
Church, the whole body of believers. In the former sense it is opposed
to repentance; in the latter the Mosaic dispensation.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p17">18. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 16" id="i.ii.vi-p17.1" parsed="|Mark|1|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.16">Mark i, 16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 1" id="i.ii.vi-p17.2" parsed="|Luke|5|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.1">Luke v, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p18">23. The Gospel of the kingdom - The Gospel, that is, the
joyous message, is the proper name of our religion: as will be amply
verified in all who earnestly and perseveringly embrace it.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p19">24. Through all Syria - The whole province, of which the
Jewish country was only a small part. And demoniacs - Men possessed with
devils: and lunatics, and paralytics - Men ill of the palsy, whose cases
were of all others most deplorable and most helpless.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vi-p20">25. Decapolis - A tract of land on the east side of the sea
of Galilee, in which were ten cities near each other.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="0.72%" prev="i.ii.vi" next="i.ii.viii" id="i.ii.vii">
<h3 id="i.ii.vii-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. v" id="i.ii.vii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5" /> 

<p id="i.ii.vii-p1">1. And seeing the multitudes - At some distance, as they
were coming to him from every quarter. He went up into the mountain -
Which was near: where there was room for them all. His disciples - not
only his twelve disciples, but all who desired to learn of him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p2">2. And he opened his mouth - A phrase which always denotes
a set and solemn discourse; and taught them - To bless men; to make men
happy, was the great business for which our Lord came into the world.
And accordingly he here pronounces eight blessings together, annexing
them to so many steps in Christianity. Knowing that happiness is our
common aim, and that an innate instinct continually urges us to the
pursuit of it, he in the kindest manner applies to that instinct, and
directs it to its proper object. Though all men desire, yet few attain,
happiness, because they seek it where it is not to be found. Our Lord
therefore begins his Divine institution, which is the complete art of
happiness, by laying down before all that have ears to hear, the true
and only true method of acquiring it. Observe the benevolent
condescension of our Lord. He seems, as it were, to lay aside his
supreme authority as our legislator, that he may the better act the part
of: our friend and saviour. Instead of using the lofty style, in
positive commands, he, in a more gentle and engaging way, insinuates his
will and our duty, by pronouncing those happy who comply with it.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p3">3. Happy are the poor - In the following discourse there
is,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.vii-p4">1. A sweet invitation to true holiness and
happiness, ver. 3-12.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.vii-p5">2. A persuasive to impart it to others, ver.
13-16.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.vii-p6">3. A description of true Christian holiness,
ver. 17; chap.vii, 12. (in which it is easy to observe, the latter part
exactly answers the former.)</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.vii-p7">4. The conclusion: giving a sure mark of the
true way, warning against false prophets, exhorting to follow after
holiness. The poor in spirit - They who are unfeignedly penitent, they
who are truly convinced of sin; who see and feel the state they are in
by nature, being deeply sensible of their sinfulness, guiltiness,
helplessness. For theirs is the kingdom of heaven - The present inward
kingdom: righteousness, and peace, and joy in the Holy Ghost, as well as
the eternal kingdom, if they endure to the end. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 20" id="i.ii.vii-p7.1" parsed="|Luke|6|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.20">Luke vi, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p8">4. They that mourn - Either for their own sins, or for
other men's, and are steadily and habitually serious. They shall be
comforted - More solidly and deeply even in this world, and eternally in
heaven.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p9">5. Happy are the meek - They that hold all their passions
and affections evenly balanced. They shall inherit the earth - They
shall have all things really necessary for life and godliness. They
shall enjoy whatever portion God hath given them here, and shall
hereafter possess the new earth, wherein dwelleth righteousness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p10">6. They that hunger and thirst after righteousness - After
the holiness here described. They shall be satisfied with it.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p11">7. The merciful - The tender-hearted: they who love all men
as themselves: They shall obtain mercy - Whatever mercy therefore we
desire from God, the same let us show to our brethren. He will repay us
a thousand fold, the love we bear to any for his sake.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p12">8. The pure in heart - The sanctified: they who love God
with all their hearts. They shall see God - In all things here;
hereafter in glory.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p13">9. The peace makers - They that out of love to God and man
do all possible good to all men. Peace in the Scripture sense implies
all blessings temporal and eternal. They shall be called the children of
God - Shall be acknowledged such by God and man. One would imagine a
person of this amiable temper and behaviour would be the darling of
mankind. But our Lord well knew it would not be so, as long as Satan was
the prince of this world. He therefore warns them before of the
treatment all were to expect, who were determined thus to tread in his
steps, by immediately subjoining, Happy are they who are persecuted for
righteousness' sake. Through this whole discourse we cannot but observe
the most exact method which can possibly be conceived. Every paragraph,
every sentence, is closely connected both with that which precedes, and
that which follows it. And is not this the pattern for every Christian
preacher? If any then are able to follow it without any premeditation,
well: if not, let them not dare to preach without it. No rhapsody, no
incoherency, whether the things spoken be true or false, comes of the
Spirit of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p14">10. For righteousness' sake - That is, because they have,
or follow after, the righteousness here described. He that is truly a
righteous man, he that mourns, and he that is pure in heart, yea, all
that will live godly in Christ Jesus, shall suffer persecution, <scripRef passage="2 Tim. iii. 12" id="i.ii.vii-p14.1" parsed="|2Tim|3|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.3.12">2 Tim. iii, 12</scripRef>. The world will always say, Away with such fellows from the
earth. They are made to reprove our thoughts. They are grievous to us
even to behold. Their lives are not like other men's; their ways are of
another fashion.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p15">11. Revile - When present: say all evil - When you are
absent.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p16">12. Your reward - Even over and above the happiness that
naturally and directly results from holiness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p17">13. Ye - Not the apostles, not ministers only; but all ye
who are thus holy, are the salt of the earth - Are to season others. <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 50" id="i.ii.vii-p17.1" parsed="|Mark|9|50|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.50">Mark ix, 50</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xiv. 34" id="i.ii.vii-p17.2" parsed="|Luke|14|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.14.34">Luke xiv,
34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p18">14. Ye are the light of the world - If ye are thus holy,
you can no more be hid than the sun in the firmament: no more than a
city on a mountain - Probably pointing to that on the brow of the
opposite hill.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p19">15. Nay, the very design of God in giving you this light
was, that it might shine. <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 21" id="i.ii.vii-p19.1" parsed="|Mark|4|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.21">Mark iv,
21</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 16; xi. 33" id="i.ii.vii-p19.2" parsed="|Luke|8|16|0|0;|Luke|11|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.16 Bible:Luke.11.33">Luke viii, 16;
xi, 33</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p20">16. That they may see - and glorify - That is, that seeing
your good works, they may be moved to love and serve God likewise.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p21">17. Think not - Do not imagine, fear, hope, that I am come
- Like your teachers, to destroy the law or the prophets. I am not come
to destroy - The moral law, but to fulfil - To establish, illustrate,
and explain its highest meaning, both by my life and doctrine.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p22">18. Till all things shall be effected - Which it either
requires or foretells. For the law has its effect, when the rewards are
given, and the punishments annexed to it inflicted, as well as when its
precepts are obeyed. <scripRef passage="Luke xvi. 17; xxi. 33" id="i.ii.vii-p22.1" parsed="|Luke|16|17|0|0;|Luke|21|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.16.17 Bible:Luke.21.33">Luke xvi,
17; xxi, 33</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p23">19. One of the least - So accounted by men; and shall teach
- Either by word or example; shall be the least - That is, shall have no
part therein.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p24">20. The righteousness of the scribes and Pharisees -
Described in the sequel of this discourse.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p25">21. Ye have heard - From the scribes reciting the law; Thou
shalt do no murder - And they interpreted this, as all the other
commandments, barely of the outward act. The judgement - The Jews had in
every city a court of twenty-three men, who could sentence a criminal to
be strangled. But the sanhedrim only (the great council which sat at
Jerusalem, consisting of seventy-two men, ) could sentence to the more
terrible death of stoning. That was called the judgment, this the
council. <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 13" id="i.ii.vii-p25.1" parsed="|Exod|20|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.13">Exod. xx, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p26">22. But I say unto you - Which of the prophets ever spake
thus? Their language is, Thus saith the Lord. Who hath authority to use
this language, but the one lawgiver, who is able to save and to destroy.
Whosoever is angry with his brother - Some copies add, without a cause -
But this is utterly foreign to the whole scope and tenor of our Lord's
discourse. If he had only forbidden the being angry without a cause,
there was no manner of need of that solemn declaration, I say unto you;
for the scribes and Pharisees themselves said as much as this. Even they
taught, men ought not to be angry without a cause. So that this
righteousness does not exceed theirs. But Christ teaches, that we ought
not, for any cause, to be so angry as to call any man Raca, or fool. We
ought not, for any cause, to be angry at the person of the sinner, but
at his sins only. Happy world, were this plain and necessary distinction
thoroughly understood, remembered, practiced! Raca means, a silly man, a
trifler. Whosoever shall say, Thou fool - Shall revile, or seriously
reproach any man. Our Lord specified three degrees of murder, each
liable to a sorer punishment than the other: not indeed from men, but
from God. Hell fire - In the valley of Hinnom (whence the word in the
original is taken) the children were used to be burnt alive to Moloch.
It was afterward made a receptacle for the filth of the city, where
continual fires were kept to consume it. And it is probable, if any
criminals were burnt alive, it was in this accursed and horrible place.
Therefore both as to its former and latter state, it was a fit emblem of
hell. It must here signify a degree of future punishment, as much more
dreadful than those incurred in the two former cases, as burning alive
is more dreadful than either strangling or stoning.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p27">23. Thy brother hath aught against thee - On any of the
preceding accounts: for any unkind thought or word: any that did not
spring from love.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p28">24. Leaving thy gift, go - For neither thy gift nor thy
prayer will atone for thy want of love: but this will make them both an
abomination before God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p29">25. Agree with thine adversary - With any against whom thou
hast thus offended: while thou art in the way - Instantly, on the spot;
before you part. Lest the adversary deliver thee to the judge - Lest he
commit his cause to God. <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 58" id="i.ii.vii-p29.1" parsed="|Luke|12|58|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.58">Luke xii,
58</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p30">26. Till thou hast paid the last farthing - That is, for
ever, since thou canst never do this. What has been hitherto said refers
to meekness: what follows, to purity of heart.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p31">27. Thou shalt not commit adultery - And this, as well as
the sixth commandment, the scribes and Pharisees interpreted barely of
the outward act. <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 14" id="i.ii.vii-p31.1" parsed="|Exod|20|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.14">Exod. xx,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p32">29, 30. If a person as dear as a right eye, or as useful as
a right hand, cause thee thus to offend, though but in heart. Perhaps
here may be an instance of a kind of transposition which is frequently
found in the sacred writings: so that the 29th verse may refer to 27,
28; and the 30th to ver. 21, 22. As if he had said, Part with any thing,
however dear to you, or otherwise useful, if you cannot avoid sin while
you keep it. Even cut off your right hand, if you are of so passionate a
temper, that you cannot otherwise be restrained from hurting your
brother. Pull out your eyes, if you can no otherwise be restrained from
lusting after women. Chap. xviii, 8; <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 43" id="i.ii.vii-p32.1" parsed="|Mark|9|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.43">Mark ix, 43</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p33">31. Let him give her a writing of divorce - Which the
scribes and Pharisees allowed men to do on any trifling occasion. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxiv. 1" id="i.ii.vii-p33.1" parsed="|Deut|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.24.1">Deut. xxiv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 7" id="i.ii.vii-p33.2" parsed="|Matt|19|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.7">Matt. xix,
7</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark x. 2" id="i.ii.vii-p33.3" parsed="|Mark|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.2">Mark x, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xvi. 18" id="i.ii.vii-p33.4" parsed="|Luke|16|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.16.18">Luke xvi, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p34">32. Causeth her to commit adultery - If she marry again.
</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p35">33. Our Lord here refers to the promise made to the pure in
heart of seeing God in all things, and points out a false doctrine of
the scribes, which arose from their not thus seeing God. What he forbids
is, the swearing at all, 1, by any creature, 2, in our ordinary
conversation: both of which the scribes and Pharisees taught to be
perfectly innocent. <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 7" id="i.ii.vii-p35.1" parsed="|Exod|20|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.7">Exod. xx,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p36">36. For thou canst not make one hair white or black -
Whereby it appears, that this also is not thine but God's.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p37">37. Let your conversation be yea, yea; nay, nay - That is,
in your common discourse, barely affirm or deny.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p38">38. Ye have heard - Our Lord proceeds to enforce such
meekness and love on those who are persecuted for righteousness' sake
(which he pursues to the end of the chapter) as were utterly unknown to
the scribes and Pharisees. It hath been said - In the law, as a
direction to Judges, in ease of violent and barbarous assaults. An eye
for an eye, and a tooth for a tooth - And this has been interpreted, as
encouraging bitter and rigorous revenge. <scripRef passage="Deut. xix. 21" id="i.ii.vii-p38.1" parsed="|Deut|19|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.19.21">Deut. xix, 21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p39">39. But I say unto you, that ye resist not the evil man -
Thus; the Greek word translated resist signifies standing in battle
array, striving for victory. If a man smite thee on the right cheek -
Return not evil for evil: yea, turn to him the other - Rather than
revenge thyself.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p40">40, 41. Where the damage is not great, choose rather to
suffer it, though possibly it may on that account be repeated, than to
demand an eye for an eye, to enter into a rigorous prosecution of the
offender. The meaning of the whole passage seems to be, rather than
return evil for evil, when the wrong is purely personal, submit to one
bodily wrong after another, give up one part of your goods after
another, submit to one instance of compulsion after another. That the
words are not literally to be understood, appears from the behaviour of
our Lord himself, <scripRef passage="John xviii. 22" id="i.ii.vii-p40.1" parsed="|John|18|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.22">John xviii,
22</scripRef>,</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p41">42. Thus much for your behaviour toward the violent. As for
those who use milder methods, Give to him that asketh thee - Give and
lend to any so far, (but no further, for God never contradicts himself)
as is consistent with thy engagements to thy creditors, thy family, and
the household of faith. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 30" id="i.ii.vii-p41.1" parsed="|Luke|6|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.30">Luke vi,
30</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p42">43. Thou shalt love thy neighbour; And hate thy enemy - God
spoke the former part; the scribes added the latter. <scripRef passage="Lev. xix. 18" id="i.ii.vii-p42.1" parsed="|Lev|19|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.18">Lev. xix, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p43">44. Bless them that curse you - Speak all the good you can
to and of them, who speak all evil to and of you. Repay love in thought,
word, and deed, to those who hate you, and show it both in word and
deed. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 27, 35" id="i.ii.vii-p43.1" parsed="|Luke|6|27|0|0;|Luke|6|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.27 Bible:Luke.6.35">Luke vi, 27, 35</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p44">45. That ye may be the children - That is, that ye may
continue and appear such before men and angels. For he maketh his sun to
rise - He gives them such blessings as they will receive at his hands.
Spiritual blessings they will not receive.</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p45">46. The publicans - were officers of the revenue, farmers,
or receivers of the public money: men employed by the Romans to gather
the taxes and customs, which they exacted of the nations they had
conquered. These were generally odious for their extortion and
oppression, and were reckoned by the Jews as the very scum of the earth.
</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p46">47. And if ye salute your friends only - Our Lord probably
glances at those prejudices, which different sects had against each
other, and intimates, that he would not have his followers imbibe that
narrow spirit. Would to God this had been more attended to among the
unhappy divisions and subdivisions, into which his Church has been
crumbled! And that we might at least advance so far, as cordially to
embrace our brethren in Christ, of whatever party or denomination they
are!</p>

<p id="i.ii.vii-p47">48. Therefore ye shall be perfect; as your Father who is in
heaven is perfect - So the original runs, referring to all that holiness
which is described in the foregoing verses, which our Lord in the
beginning of the chapter recommends as happiness, and in the close of it
as perfection. And how wise and gracious is this, to sum up, and, as it
were, seal all his commandments with a promise! Even the proper promise
of the Gospel! That he will put those laws in our minds, and write them
in our hearts! He well knew how ready our unbelief would be to cry out,
this is impossible! And therefore stakes upon it all the power, truth,
and faithfulness of him to whom all things are possible.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="0.99%" prev="i.ii.vii" next="i.ii.ix" id="i.ii.viii">
<h3 id="i.ii.viii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. vi" id="i.ii.viii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.6" /> 

<p id="i.ii.viii-p1">1. In the foregoing chapter our Lord particularly described
the nature of inward holiness. In this he describes that purity of
intention without which none of our outward actions are holy. This
chapter contains four parts,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.viii-p2">1. The right intention and manner of giving
alms, ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.viii-p3">2. The right intention, manner, form, and
prerequisites of prayer, ver. 5-15.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.viii-p4">3. The right intention, and manner of
fasting, ver. 16-18.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.viii-p5">4. The necessity of a pure intention in all
things, unmixed either with the desire of riches, or worldly care, and
fear of want, ver. 19-34. This verse is a general caution against vain
glory, in any of our good works: All these are here summed up together,
in the comprehensive word righteousness. This general caution our Lord
applies in the sequel to the three principal branches of it, relating to
our neighbour, ver. 2-iv, to God, ver. 5, vi, and to ourselves, ver.
16-18. To be seen - Barely the being seen, while we are doing any of
these things, is a circumstance purely indifferent. But the doing them
with this view, to be seen and admired, this is what our Lord
condemns.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p6">2. As the hypocrites do - Many of the scribes and Pharisees
did this, under a pretense of calling the poor together. They have their
reward - All they will have; for they shall have none from God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p7">3. Let not thy left hand know what thy right hand doth - A
proverbial expression for doing a thing secretly. Do it as secretly as
is consistent,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.viii-p8">1. With the doing it at all.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.viii-p9">2. With the doing it in the most effectual
manner.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p10">5. The synagogues - These were properly the places where
the people assembled for public prayer, and hearing the Scriptures read
and expounded. They were in every city from the time of the Babylonish
captivity, and had service in them thrice a day on three days in the
week. In every synagogue was a council of grave and wise persons, over
whom was a president, called the ruler of the synagogue. But the word
here, as well as in many other texts, signifies any place of public
concourse.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p11">6. Enter into thy closet - That is, do it with as much
secrecy as thou canst.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p12">7. Use not vain repetitions - To repeat any words without
meaning them, is certainly a vain repetition. Therefore we should be
extremely careful in all our prayers to mean what we say; and to say
only what we mean from the bottom of our hearts. The vain and heathenish
repetitions which we are here warned against, are most dangerous, and
yet very common; which is a principal cause why so many, who still
profess religion, are a disgrace to it. Indeed all the words in the
world are not equivalent to one holy desire. And the very best prayers
are but vain repetitions, if they are not the language of the heart.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p13">8. Your Father knoweth what things ye have need of - We do
not pray to inform God of our wants. Omniscient as he is, he cannot be
informed of any thing which he knew not before: and he is always willing
to relieve them. The chief thing wanting is, a fit disposition on our
part to receive his grace and blessing. Consequently, one great office
of prayer is, to produce such a disposition in us: to exercise our
dependence on God; to increase our desire of the things we ask for; to
us so sensible of our wants, that we may never cease wrestling till we
have prevailed for the blessing.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p14">9. Thus therefore pray ye - He who best knew what we ought
to pray for, and how we ought to pray, what matter of desire, what
manner of address would most please himself, would best become us, has
here dictated to us a most perfect and universal form of prayer,
comprehending all our real wants, expressing all our lawful desires; a
complete directory and full exercise of all our devotions. Thus - For
these things; sometimes in these words, at least in this manner, short,
close, full. This prayer consists of three parts, the preface, the
petitions, and the conclusion. The preface, Our Father, who art in
heaven, lays a general foundation for prayer, comprising what we must
first know of God, before we can pray in confidence of being heard. It
likewise points out to us our that faith, humility, love, of God and
man, with which we are to approach God in prayer.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p15">10. Our Father - Who art good and gracious to all, our
Creator, our Preserver; the Father of our Lord, and of us in him, thy
children by adoption and grace: not my Father only, who now cry unto
thee, but the Father of the universe, of angels and men: who art in
heaven - Beholding all things, both in heaven and earth; knowing every
creature, and all the works of every creature, and every possible event
from everlasting to everlasting: the almighty Lord and Ruler of all,
superintending and disposing all things; in heaven - Eminently there,
but not there alone, seeing thou fillest heaven and earth. II.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p16">1. Hallowed be thy name - Mayest thou, O Father, be truly
known by all intelligent beings, and with affections suitable to that
knowledge: mayest thou be duly honoured, loved, feared, by all in heaven
and in earth, by all angels and all men.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p17">2. Thy kingdom come - May thy kingdom of grace come
quickly, and swallow up all the kingdoms of the earth: may all mankind,
receiving thee, O Christ, for their king, truly believing in thy name,
be filled with righteousness, and peace, and joy; with holiness and
happiness, till they are removed hence into thy kingdom of glory, to
reign with thee forever and ever.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p18">3. Thy will be done on earth, as it is in heaven - May all
the inhabitants of the earth do thy will as willingly as the holy
angels: may these do it continually even as they, without any
interruption of their willing service; yea, and perfectly as they:
mayest thou, O Spirit of grace, through the blood of the everlasting
covenant, make them perfect in every good work to do thy will, and work
in them all that is well pleasing in thy sight.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p19">4. Give us - O Father (for we claim nothing of right, but
only of thy free mercy) this day - (for we take no thought for the
morrow) our daily bread - All things needful for our souls and bodies:
not only the meat that perisheth, but the sacramental bread, and thy
grace, the food which endureth to everlasting life.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p20">5. And forgive us our debts, as we also forgive our debtors
- Give us, O Lord, redemption in thy blood, even the forgiveness of
sins: as thou enablest us freely and fully to forgive every man, so do
thou forgive all our trespasses.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p21">6. And lead us not into temptation, but deliver us from
evil - Whenever we are tempted, O thou that helpest our infirmities,
suffer us not to enter into temptation; to be overcome or suffer loss
thereby; but make a way for us to escape, so that we may be more than
conquerors, through thy love, over sin and all the consequences of it.
Now the principal desire of a Christian's heart being the glory of God,
(ver. 9, 10, ) and all he wants for himself or his brethren being the
daily bread of soul and body, (or the support of life, animal and
spiritual, ) pardon of sin, and deliverance from the power of it and of
the devil, (ver. 11, 12, 13, ) there is nothing beside that a Christian
can wish for; therefore this prayer comprehends all his desires. Eternal
life is the certain consequence, or rather completion of holiness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p22">III. For thine is the kingdom - The sovereign right of all
things that are or ever were created: The power - the executive power,
whereby thou governest all things in thy everlasting kingdom: And the
glory - The praise due from every creature, for thy power, and all thy
wondrous works, and the mightiness of thy kingdom, which endureth
through all ages, even forever and ever. It is observable, that though
the doxology, as well as the petitions of this prayer, is threefold, and
is directed to the Father, Son, and Holy Ghost distinctly, yet is the
whole fully applicable both to every person, and to the ever - blessed
and undivided trinity. <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 2" id="i.ii.viii-p22.1" parsed="|Luke|11|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.2">Luke xi, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p23">14. <scripRef passage="Mark xi. 25" id="i.ii.viii-p23.1" parsed="|Mark|11|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11.25">Mark xi,
25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p24">16. When ye fast? - Our Lord does not enjoin either
fasting, alms- deeds, or prayer: all these being duties which were
before fully established in the Church of God. Disfigure - By the dust
and ashes which they put upon their heads, as was usual at the times of
solemn humiliation.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p25">17. Anoint thy head - So the Jews frequently did. Dress
thyself as usual.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p26">19. Lay not up for yourselves - Our Lord here makes a
transition from religious to common actions, and warns us of another
snare, the love of money, as inconsistent with purity of intention as
the love of praise. Where rust and moth consume - Where all things are
perishable and transient. He may likewise have a further view in these
words, even to guard us against making any thing on earth our treasure.
For then a thing properly becomes our treasure, when we set our
affections upon it. <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 33" id="i.ii.viii-p26.1" parsed="|Luke|12|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.33">Luke xii,
33</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p27">21. <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 34" id="i.ii.viii-p27.1" parsed="|Luke|11|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.34">Luke xi,
34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p28">22. The eye is the lamp of the body - And what the eye is
to the body, the intention is to the soul. We may observe with what
exact propriety our Lord places purity of intention between worldly
desires and worldly cares, either of which directly tend to destroy. If
thine eye be single - Singly fixed on God and heaven, thy whole soul
will be full of holiness and happiness. If thine eye be evil - Not
single, aiming at any thing else.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p29">24. Mammon - Riches, money; any thing loved or sought,
without reference to God. <scripRef passage="Luke xvi. 13" id="i.ii.viii-p29.1" parsed="|Luke|16|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.16.13">Luke xvi,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p30">25. And if you serve God, you need be careful for nothing.
Therefore take no thought - That is, be not anxiously careful. Beware
of worldly cares; for these are as inconsistent with the true service of
God as worldly desires. Is not the life more than meat? - And if God
give the greater gift, will he deny the smaller? <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 22" id="i.ii.viii-p30.1" parsed="|Luke|12|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.22">Luke xii, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p31">27. And which of you - If you are ever so careful, can even
add a moment to your own life thereby? This seems to be far the most
easy and natural sense of the words.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p32">29. Solomon in all his glory was not arrayed like one of
these - Not in garments of so pure a white. The eastern monarchs were
often clothed in white robes.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p33">30. The grass of the field - is a general expression,
including both herbs and flowers. Into the still - This is the natural
sense of the passage. For it can hardly be supposed that grass or
flowers should be thrown into the oven the day after they were cut down.
Neither is it the custom in the hottest countries, where they dry
fastest, to heat ovens with them. If God so clothe - The word properly
implies, the putting on a complete dress, that surrounds the body on all
sides; and beautifully expresses that external membrane, which (like the
skin in a human body) at once adorns the tender fabric of the vegetable,
and guards it from the injuries of the weather. Every microscope in
which a flower is viewed gives a lively comment on this text.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p34">31. Therefore take not thought - How kind are these
precepts! The substance of which is only this, Do thyself no harm! Let
us not be so ungrateful to him, nor so injurious to ourselves, as to
harass and oppress our minds with that burden of anxiety, which he has
so graciously taken off. Every verse speaks at once to the
understanding, and to the heart. We will not therefore indulge these
unnecessary, these useless, these mischievous cares. We will not borrow
the anxieties and distresses of the morrow, to aggravate those of the
present day. Rather we will cheerfully repose ourselves on that heavenly
Father, who knows we have need of these things; who has given us the
life, which is more than meat, and the body, which is more than raiment.
And thus instructed in the philosophy of our heavenly Master, we will
learn a lesson of faith and cheer. fulness from every bird of the air,
and every flower of the field.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p35">33. Seek the kingdom of God and his righteousness - Singly
aim at this, that God, reigning in your heart, may fill it with the
righteousness above described. And indeed whosoever seeks this first,
will soon come to seek this only.</p>

<p id="i.ii.viii-p36">34. The morrow shall take thought for itself - That is, be
careful for the morrow when it comes. The evil thereof - Speaking after
the manner of men. But all trouble is, upon the whole, a real good. It
is good physic which God dispenses daily to his children, according to
the need and the strength of each.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="1.20%" prev="i.ii.viii" next="i.ii.x" id="i.ii.ix">
<h3 id="i.ii.ix-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. vii" id="i.ii.ix-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7" /> 

<p id="i.ii.ix-p1">Our Lord now proceeds to warn us against the chief
hindrances of holiness. And how wisely does he begin with judging?
wherein all young converts are so apt to spend that zeal which is given
them for better purposes.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p2">1. Judge not - any man without full, clear, certain
knowledge, without absolute necessity, without tender love. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 37" id="i.ii.ix-p2.1" parsed="|Luke|6|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.37">Luke vi, 37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p3">2. With what measure ye mete, it shall be measured to you -
Awful words! So we may, as it were, choose for ourselves, whether God
shall be severe or merciful to us. God and man will favour the candid
and benevolent: but they must expect judgment without mercy, who have
showed no mercy.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p4">3. In particular, why do you open your eyes to any fault of
your brother, while you yourself are guilty of a much greater? The mote
- The word properly signifies a splinter or shiver of wood. This and a
beam, its opposite, were proverbially used by the Jews, to denote, the
one, small infirmities, the other, gross, palpable faults. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 41" id="i.ii.ix-p4.1" parsed="|Luke|6|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.41">Luke vi, 41</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p5">4. How sayest thou - With what face?</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p6">5. Thou hypocrite - It is mere hypocrisy to pretend zeal
for the amendment of others while we have none for our own. Then - When
that which obstructed thy sight is removed.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p7">6. Here is another instance of that transposition, where of
the two things proposed, the latter is first treated of. Give not - to
dogs - lest turning they rend you: Cast not - to swine - lest they
trample them under foot. Yet even then, when the beam is cast out of
thine own eye, Give not - That is, talk not of the deep things of God to
those whom you know to be wallowing in sin. neither declare the great
things God hath done for your soul to the profane, furious, persecuting
wretches. Talk not of perfection, for instance, to the former; not of
your experience to the latter. But our Lord does in nowise forbid us to
reprove, as occasion is, both the one and the other.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p8">7. But ask - Pray for them, as well as for yourselves: in
this there can be no such danger. Seek - Add your own diligent
endeavours to your asking: and knock - Persevere importunately in that
diligence. <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 9" id="i.ii.ix-p8.1" parsed="|Luke|11|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.9">Luke xi, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p9">8. For every one that asketh receiveth - Provided he ask
aright, and ask what is agreeable to God's will.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p10">11. To them that ask him - But on this condition, that ye
follow the example of his goodness, by doing to all as ye would they
should do to you. For this is the law and the prophets - This is the sum
of all, exactly answering Chap. v, 17. The whole is comprised in one
word, Imitate the God of love. Thus far proceeds the doctrinal part of
the sermon. In the next verse begins the exhortation to practice it.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p11">12. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 31" id="i.ii.ix-p11.1" parsed="|Luke|6|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.31">Luke vi,
31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p12">13. The strait gate - The holiness described in the
foregoing chapters. And this is the narrow way. Wide is the gate, and
many there are that go in through it - They need not seek for this; they
come to it of course. Many go in through it, because strait is the other
gate - Therefore they do not care for it; they like a wider gate. <scripRef passage="Luke xiii. 24" id="i.ii.ix-p12.1" parsed="|Luke|13|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13.24">Luke xiii, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p13">15. Beware of false prophets - Who in their preaching
describe a broad way to heaven: it is their prophesying, their teaching
the broad way, rather than their walking in it themselves, that is here
chiefly spoken of. All those are false prophets, who teach any other way
than that our Lord hath here marked out. In sheep's clothing - With
outside religion and fair professions of love: Wolves - Not feeding, but
destroying souls.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p14">16. By their fruits ye shall know them - A short, plain,
easy rule, whereby to know true from false prophets: and one that may be
applied by people of the weakest capacity, who are not accustomed to
deep reasoning. True prophets convert sinners to God, or at least
confirm and strengthen those that are converted. False prophets do not.
They also are false prophets, who though speaking the very truth, yet
are not sent by the Spirit of God, but come in their own name, to
declare it: their grand mark is, "Not turning men from the power of
Satan to God." <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 43, 44" id="i.ii.ix-p14.1" parsed="|Luke|6|43|6|44" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.43-Luke.6.44">Luke vi, 43,
44</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p15">18. A good tree cannot bring forth evil fruit, neither a
corrupt tree good fruit - But it is certain, the goodness or badness
here mentioned respects the doctrine, rather than the personal
character. For a bad man preaching the good doctrine here delivered, is
sometimes an instrument of converting sinners to God. Yet I do not aver,
that all are true prophets who speak the truth, and thereby convert
sinners. I only affirm, that none are such who do not.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p16">19. Every tree that bringeth not forth good fruit is hewn
down and cast into the fire - How dreadful then is the condition of that
teacher who hath brought no sinners to God!</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p17">21. Not every one - That is, no one that saith, Lord, Lord
- That makes a mere profession of me and my religion, shall enter -
Whatever their false teachers may assure them to the contrary: He that
doth the will of my Father - as I have now declared it. Observe: every
thing short of this is only saying, Lord, Lord. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 46" id="i.ii.ix-p17.1" parsed="|Luke|6|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.46">Luke vi, 46</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p18">22. We have prophesied - We have declared the mysteries of
thy kingdom, wrote books; preached excellent sermons: In thy name done
many wonderful works - So that even the working of miracles is no proof
that a man has saving faith.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p19">23. I never knew you - There never was a time that I
approved of you: so that as many souls as they had saved, they were
themselves never saved from their sins. Lord, is it my case? <scripRef passage="Luke xiii. 27" id="i.ii.ix-p19.1" parsed="|Luke|13|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13.27">Luke xiii, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p20">24. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 47" id="i.ii.ix-p20.1" parsed="|Luke|6|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.47">Luke vi,
47</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.ix-p21">29. He taught them - The multitudes, as one having
authority - With a dignity and majesty peculiar to himself as the great
Lawgiver, and with the demonstration and power of the Spirit: and not as
the scribes - Who only expounded the law of another; and that in a
lifeless, ineffectual manner.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="1.30%" prev="i.ii.ix" next="i.ii.xi" id="i.ii.x">
<h3 id="i.ii.x-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. viii" id="i.ii.x-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8" /> 

<p id="i.ii.x-p1">2. A leper came - Leprosies in those countries were seldom
curable by natural means, any more than palsies or lunacy. Probably this
leper, though he might not mix with the people, had heard our Lord at a
distance. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 40" id="i.ii.x-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|1|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.40">Mark i, 40</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 12" id="i.ii.x-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|5|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.12">Luke v, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p2">4. See thou tell no man - Perhaps our Lord only meant here,
Not till thou hast showed thyself to the priest-who was appointed to
inquire into the case of leprosy. But many others he commanded,
absolutely, to tell none of the miracles he had wrought upon them. And
this he seems to have done, chiefly for one or more of these
reasons:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.x-p3">1. To prevent the multitude from thronging
him, in the manner related <scripRef passage="Mark i. 45" id="i.ii.x-p3.1" parsed="|Mark|1|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.45">Mark i,
45</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.x-p4">2. To fulfil the prophecy, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xlii. 1" id="i.ii.x-p4.1" parsed="|Isa|42|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.42.1">Isaiah xlii, 1</scripRef>, that he would not be vain or ostentatious. This reason St.
Matthew assigns, chap. xii, 17, &amp;c.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.x-p5">3. To avoid the being taken by force and made
a king, <scripRef passage="John vi. 15" id="i.ii.x-p5.1" parsed="|John|6|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.6.15">John vi, 15</scripRef>. And,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.x-p6">4. That he might not enrage the chief
priests, scribes, and Pharisees, who were the most bitter against him,
any more than was unavoidable, <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 20, 21" id="i.ii.x-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|16|20|16|21" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.20-Matt.16.21">Matt. xvi, 20, 21</scripRef>. For a testimony - That I am the Messiah; to them - The
priests, who otherwise might have pleaded want of evidence. <scripRef passage="Lev. xiv. 2" id="i.ii.x-p6.2" parsed="|Lev|14|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.14.2">Lev. xiv, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p7">5. There came to him a centurion - A captain of a hundred
Roman soldiers. Probably he came a little way toward him, and then went
back. He thought himself not worthy to come in person, and therefore
spoke the words that follow by his messengers. As it is not unusual in
all languages, so in the Hebrew it is peculiarly frequent, to ascribe to
a person himself the thing which is done, and the words which are spoken
by his order. And accordingly St. Matthew relates as said by the
centurion himself, what others said by order from him. An instance of
the same kind we have in the case of Zebedee's children. From St. <scripRef passage="Matthew xx. 20" id="i.ii.x-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|20|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.20">Matthew xx, 20</scripRef>, we learn it was their mother that spoke those words, which,
<scripRef passage="Mark x. 35, 37" id="i.ii.x-p7.2" parsed="|Mark|10|35|0|0;|Mark|10|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.35 Bible:Mark.10.37">Mark x, 35, 37</scripRef>, themselves are said to speak; because she was only their
mouth. Yet from ver. 13, Go thy way home, it appears he at length came
in person, probably on hearing that Jesus was nearer to his house than
he apprehended when he sent the second message by his friends. <scripRef passage="Luke vii. 1" id="i.ii.x-p7.3" parsed="|Luke|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.7.1">Luke vii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p8">8. The centurion answered - By his second messengers.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p9">9. For I am a man under authority - I am only an inferior
officer: and what I command, is done even in my absence: how much more
what thou commandest, who art Lord of all!</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p10">10. I have not found so great faith, no, not in Israel -
For the centurion was not an Israelite.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p11">11. Many from the farthest parts of the earth shall embrace
the terms and enjoy the rewards of the Gospel covenant established with
Abraham. But the Jews, who have the first title to them, shall be shut
out from the feast; from grace here, and hereafter from glory. <scripRef passage="Luke xiii. 29" id="i.ii.x-p11.1" parsed="|Luke|13|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13.29">Luke xiii, 29</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p12">12. The outer darkness - Our Lord here alludes to the
custom the ancients had of making their feast in the night time.
Probably while he was speaking this, the centurion came in person. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 42, 50; xxii. 13; xxiv. 51; xxv. 30" id="i.ii.x-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|13|42|0|0;|Matt|13|50|0|0;|Matt|22|13|0|0;|Matt|24|51|0|0;|Matt|25|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.42 Bible:Matt.13.50 Bible:Matt.22.13 Bible:Matt.24.51 Bible:Matt.25.30">Matt. xiii, 42, 50; xxii, 13;
xxiv, 51; xxv, 30</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p13">14. Peter's wife's mother - St. Peter was then a young man,
as were all the apostles. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 29" id="i.ii.x-p13.1" parsed="|Mark|1|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.29">Mark i,
29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 38" id="i.ii.x-p13.2" parsed="|Luke|4|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.38">Luke iv,
38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p14">16. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 32" id="i.ii.x-p14.1" parsed="|Mark|1|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.32">Mark i, 32</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 40" id="i.ii.x-p14.2" parsed="|Luke|4|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.40">Luke iv, 40</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p15">17. Whereby was fulfilled what was spoken by the Prophet
Isaiah - He spoke it in a more exalted sense. The evangelist here only
alludes to those words, as being capable of this lower meaning also.
Such instances are frequent in the sacred writings, and are elegancies
rather than imperfections. He fulfilled these words in the highest
sense, by bearing our sins in his own body on the tree: in a lower
sense, by sympathizing with us in our sorrows, and healing us of the
diseases which were the fruit of sin. <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 4" id="i.ii.x-p15.1" parsed="|Isa|53|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.4">Isaiah liii, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p16">18. He commanded to go to the other side - That both
himself and the people might have a little rest.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p17">19. <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 57" id="i.ii.x-p17.1" parsed="|Luke|9|57|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.57">Luke ix,
57</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p18">20. The Son of man - The expression is borrowed from <scripRef passage="Dan. vii. 13" id="i.ii.x-p18.1" parsed="|Dan|7|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.7.13">Dan. vii, 13</scripRef>, and is the appellation which Christ generally gives
himself: which he seems to do out of humility, as having some relation
to his mean appearance in this world. Hath not where to lay his head -
Therefore do not follow me from any view of temporal advantage.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p19">21. Another said - I will follow thee without any such
view; but I must mind my business first. It is not certain that his
father was already dead. Perhaps his son desired to stay with him, being
very old, till his death.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p20">22. But Jesus said - When God calls, leave the business of
the world to them who are dead to God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p21">23. <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 35" id="i.ii.x-p21.1" parsed="|Mark|4|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.35">Mark iv, 35</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 22" id="i.ii.x-p21.2" parsed="|Luke|8|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.22">Luke viii, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p22">24. The ship was covered - So man's extremity is God's
opportunity.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p23">26. Why are ye fearful - Then he rebuked the winds - First,
he composed their spirits, and then the sea.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p24">28. The country of the Gergesenes - Or of the Gadarenes -
Gergesa and Gadara were towns near each other. Hence the country between
them took its name, sometimes from the one, sometimes from the other.
There met him two demoniacs - St. Mark and St. Luke mention only one,
who was probably the fiercer of the two, and the person who spoke to our
Lord first. But this is no way inconsistent with the account which St.
Matthew gives. The tombs - Doubtless those malevolent spirits love such
tokens of death and destruction. Tombs were usually in those days in
desert places, at a distance from towns, and were often made in the
sides of caves, in the rocks and mountains. No one could pass - Safely. <scripRef passage="Mark v. 1" id="i.ii.x-p24.1" parsed="|Mark|5|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.5.1">Mark v, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 26" id="i.ii.x-p24.2" parsed="|Luke|8|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.26">Luke viii, 26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p25">29. What have we to do with thee - This is a Hebrew phrase,
which signifies. Why do you concern yourself about us? <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xvi. 10" id="i.ii.x-p25.1" parsed="|2Sam|16|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.16.10">2 Sam. xvi, 10</scripRef>. Before the time - The great day.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p26">30. There was a herd of many swine - Which it was not
lawful for the Jews to keep. Therefore our Lord both justly and
mercifully permitted them to be destroyed.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p27">31. He said, Go - A word of permission only, not
command.</p>

<p id="i.ii.x-p28">34. They besought him to depart out of their coasts - They
loved their swine so much better than their souls! How many are of the
same mind!</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="1.41%" prev="i.ii.x" next="i.ii.xii" id="i.ii.xi">
<h3 id="i.ii.xi-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. ix" id="i.ii.xi-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xi-p1">1. His own city - Capernaum, chap. iv, 13; <scripRef passage="Mark v. 18" id="i.ii.xi-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|5|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.5.18">Mark v, 18</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 37" id="i.ii.xi-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|8|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.37">Luke viii, 37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p2">2. Seeing their faith - Both that of the paralytic, and of
them that brought him. Son - A title of tenderness and condescension. <scripRef passage="Mark ii. 3" id="i.ii.xi-p2.1" parsed="|Mark|2|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2.3">Mark ii, 3</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 18" id="i.ii.xi-p2.2" parsed="|Luke|5|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.18">Luke v,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p3">3. This man blasphemeth - Attributing to himself a power
(that of forgiving sins) which belongs to God only.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p4">5. Which is easier - Do not both of them argue a Divine
power? Therefore if I can heal his disease, I can forgive his sins:
especially as his disease is the consequence of his sins. Therefore
these must be taken away, if that is.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p5">6. On earth - Even in my state of humiliation.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p6">8. So what was to the scribes an occasion of blaspheming,
was to the people an incitement to praise God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p7">9. He saw a man named Matthew - Modestly so called by
himself. The other evangelists call him by his more honourable name,
Levi. Sitting - In the very height of his business, at the receipt of
custom - The custom house, or place where the customs were received. <scripRef passage="Mark ii. 14" id="i.ii.xi-p7.1" parsed="|Mark|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2.14">Mark ii, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 27" id="i.ii.xi-p7.2" parsed="|Luke|5|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.27">Luke v, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p8">10. As Jesus sat at table in the house - Of Matthew, who
having invited many of his old companions, made him a feast, <scripRef passage="Mark ii. 15" id="i.ii.xi-p8.1" parsed="|Mark|2|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2.15">Mark ii, 15</scripRef>; and that a great one, though he does not himself mention
it. The publicans, or collectors of the taxes which the Jews paid the
Romans, were infamous for their illegal exactions: Sinners - Open,
notorious, sinners.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p9">11. The Pharisees said to his disciples, Why eateth your
Master? - Thus they commonly ask our Lord, Why do thy disciples this?
And his disciples, Why doth your Master?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p10">13. Go ye and learn - Ye that take upon you to teach
others. I will have mercy and not sacrifice - That is, I will have mercy
rather than sacrifice. I love acts of mercy better than sacrifice
itself. <scripRef passage="Hosea vi. 6" id="i.ii.xi-p10.1" parsed="|Hos|6|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.6.6">Hosea vi, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p11">14. Then - While he was at table. <scripRef passage="Mark ii. 18" id="i.ii.xi-p11.1" parsed="|Mark|2|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2.18">Mark ii, 18</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 33" id="i.ii.xi-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|5|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.33">Luke v, 33</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p12">15. The children of the bride chamber - The companions of
the bridegroom. Mourn - Mourning and fasting usually go together. As if
he had said, While I am with them, it is a festival time, a season of
rejoicing, not mourning. But after I am gone, all my disciples likewise
shall be in fastings often.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p13">16. This is one reason, - It is not a proper time for them
to fast. Another is, they are not ripe for it. New cloth - The words in
the original properly signify cloth that hath not passed through the
fuller's hands, and which is consequently much harsher than what has
been washed and worn; and therefore yielding less than that, will tear
away the edges to which it is sewed.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p14">17. New - Fermenting wine will soon burst those bottles,
the leather of which is almost worn out. The word properly means vessels
made of goats' skins, wherein they formerly put wine, (and do in some
countries to this day) to convey it from place to place. Put new wine
into new bottles - Give harsh doctrines to such as have strength to
receive them.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p15">18. Just dead - He had left her at the point of death, <scripRef passage="Mark v. 23" id="i.ii.xi-p15.1" parsed="|Mark|5|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.5.23">Mark v, 23</scripRef>. Probably a messenger had now informed him she was dead. <scripRef passage="Mark v. 22" id="i.ii.xi-p15.2" parsed="|Mark|5|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.5.22">Mark v, 22</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 41" id="i.ii.xi-p15.3" parsed="|Luke|8|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.41">Luke
viii, 41</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p16">20. Coming behind - Out of bashfulness and humility.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p17">22. Take courage - Probably she was struck with fear, when
he turned and looked upon her, <scripRef passage="Mark v. 33" id="i.ii.xi-p17.1" parsed="|Mark|5|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.5.33">Mark v,
33</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 47" id="i.ii.xi-p17.2" parsed="|Luke|8|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.47">Luke viii,
47</scripRef>; lest she should have offended him, by touching his garment
privately; and the more so, because she was unclean according to the
law, <scripRef passage="Lev. xv. 25" id="i.ii.xi-p17.3" parsed="|Lev|15|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.15.25">Lev. xv, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p18">23. The minstrels - The musicians. The original word means
flute players. Musical instruments were used by the Jews as well as the
heathens, in their Lamentations for the dead, to soothe the melancholy
of surviving friends, by soft and solemn notes. And there were persons
who made it their business to perform this, while others sung to their
music. Flutes were used especially on the death of children; louder
instruments on the death of grown persons.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p19">24. Withdraw - There is no need of you now; for the maid is
not dead - Her life is not at an end; but sleepeth - This is only a
temporary suspension of sense and motion, which should rather be termed
sleep than death.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p20">25. The maid arose - Christ raised three dead persons to
life; this child, the widow's son, and Lazarus: one newly departed,
another on the bier, the third smelling in the grave: to show us that no
degree of death is so desperate as to be past his help.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p21">32. <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 14" id="i.ii.xi-p21.1" parsed="|Luke|11|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.14">Luke xi,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p22">33. Even in Israel - Where so many wonders have been
seen.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p23">36. Because they were faint - In soul rather than in body.
As sheep having no shepherd - And yet they had many teachers; they had
scribes in every city. But they had none who cared for their souls, and
none that were able, if they had been willing, to have wrought any
deliverance. They had no pastors after God's own heart.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p24">37. The harvest truly is great - When Christ came into the
world, it was properly the time of harvest; till then it was the seed
time only. But the labourers are few - Those whom God sends; who are
holy, and convert sinners. Of others there are many. <scripRef passage="Luke x. 2" id="i.ii.xi-p24.1" parsed="|Luke|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.2">Luke x, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xi-p25">38. The Lord of the harvest - Whose peculiar work and
office it is, and who alone is able to do it: that he would thrust forth
- for it is an employ not pleasing to flesh and blood; so full of
reproach, labour, danger, temptation of every kind, that nature may well
be averse to it. Those who never felt this, never yet knew what it is to
be labourers in Christ's harvest. He sends them forth, when he calls
them by his Spirit, furnishes them with grace and gifts for the work,
and makes a way for them to be employed therein.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="1.50%" prev="i.ii.xi" next="i.ii.xiii" id="i.ii.xii">
<h3 id="i.ii.xii-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. x" id="i.ii.xii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xii-p1">1. His twelve disciples - Hence it appears that he had
already chosen out of his disciples, those whom he afterward termed
apostles. The number seems to have relation to the twelve patriarchs,
and the twelve tribes of Israel. <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 14; vi. 7" id="i.ii.xii-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|3|14|0|0;|Mark|6|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.14 Bible:Mark.6.7">Mark iii, 14; vi, 7;</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 13; ix. 1" id="i.ii.xii-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|6|13|0|0;|Luke|9|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.13 Bible:Luke.9.1">Luke vi, 13; ix, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p2">2. The first, Simon - The first who was called to a
constant attendance on Christ; although Andrew had seen him before
Simon. <scripRef passage="Acts i. 13" id="i.ii.xii-p2.1" parsed="|Acts|1|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1.13">Acts i, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p3">3. Lebbeus - Commonly called Judas, the brother of
James.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p4">4. Iscariot - So called from Iscarioth, (the place of his
birth, ) a town of the tribe of Ephraim, near the city of Samaria.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p5">5. These twelve Jesus sent forth - Herein exercising his
supreme authority, as God over all. None but God can give men authority
to preach his word. Go not - Their commission was thus confined now,
because the calling of the Gentiles was deferred till after the more
plentiful effusion of the Holy Ghost on the day of pentecost. Enter not
- Not to preach; but they might to buy what they wanted, <scripRef passage="John iv. 9" id="i.ii.xii-p5.1" parsed="|John|4|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.4.9">John iv, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p6">8. Cast out devils - It is a great relief to the spirits of
an infidel, sinking under a dread, that possibly the Gospel may be true,
to find it observed by a learned brother, that the diseases therein
ascribed to the operation of the devil have the very same symptoms with
the natural diseases of lunacy, epilepsy, or convulsions; whence he
readily and very willingly concludes, that the devil had no hand in
them. But it were well to stop and consider a little. Suppose God should
suffer an evil spirit to usurp the same power over a man's body, as the
man himself has naturally; and suppose him actually to exercise that
power; could we conclude the devil had no hand therein, because his body
was bent in the very same manner wherein the man himself might have bent
it naturally? And suppose God gives an evil spirit a greater power, to
effect immediately the organ of the nerves in the brain, by irritating
them to produce violent motions, or so relaxing them that they can
produce little or no motion; still the symptoms will be those of over
tense nerves, as in madness, epilepsies, convulsions; or of relaxed
nerves, as in paralytic cases. But could we conclude thence that the
devil had no hand in them? Will any man affirm that God cannot or will
not, on any occasion whatever, give such a power to an evil spirit? Or
that effects, the like of which may be produced by natural causes,
cannot possibly be produced by preternatural? If this be possible, then
he who affirms it was so, in any particular case, cannot be justly
charged with falsehood, merely for affirming the reality of a possible
thing. Yet in this manner are the evangelists treated by those unhappy
men, who above all things dread the truth of the Gospel, because, if it
is true, they are of all men the most miserable. Freely ye have received
- All things; in particular the power of working miracles; freely give -
Exert that power wherever you come. <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 7" id="i.ii.xii-p6.1" parsed="|Mark|6|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.7">Mark
vi, 7</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 2" id="i.ii.xii-p6.2" parsed="|Luke|9|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.2">Luke ix,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p7">9. Provide not - The stress seems to lie on this word: they
might use what they had ready; but they might not stay a moment to
provide any thing more, neither take any thought about it. Nor indeed
were they to take any thing with them, more than was strictly
necessary.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xii-p8">1. Lest it should retard them.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xii-p9">2. Because they were to learn hereby to trust
to God in all future exigencies.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p10">10. Neither scrip - That is, a wallet, or bag to hold
provisions: Nor yet a staff - We read, <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 8" id="i.ii.xii-p10.1" parsed="|Mark|6|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.8">Mark vi, 8</scripRef>, Take nothing, save a staff only. He that had one might take
it; they that had none, might not provide any. For the workman is worthy
of his maintenance - The word includes all that is mentioned in the 9th
and 10th verses; all that they were forbidden to provide for themselves,
so far as it was needful for them. <scripRef passage="Luke x. 7" id="i.ii.xii-p10.2" parsed="|Luke|10|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.7">Luke x, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p11">11. Inquire who is worthy - That you should abide with him:
who is disposed to receive the Gospel. There abide - In that house, till
ye leave the town. <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 10" id="i.ii.xii-p11.1" parsed="|Mark|6|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.10">Mark vi,
10</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 4" id="i.ii.xii-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|9|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.4">Luke ix, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p12">12. Salute it - In the usual Jewish form, "Peace (that is,
all blessings) be to this house."</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p13">13. If the house be worthy - of it, God shall give them the
peace you wish them. If not, he shall give you what they refuse. The
same will be the case, when we pray for them that are not worthy.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p14">14. Shake off the dust from your feet - The Jews thought
the land of Israel so peculiarly holy, that when they came home from any
heathen country, they stopped at the borders and shook or wiped off the
dust of it from their feet, that the holy land might not be polluted
with it. Therefore the action here enjoined was a lively intimation,
that those Jews who had rejected the Gospel were holy no longer, but
were on a level with heathens and idolaters.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p15">16. <scripRef passage="Luke x. 3" id="i.ii.xii-p15.1" parsed="|Luke|10|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.3">Luke x, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p16">17. But think not that all your innocence and all your
wisdom will screen you from persecution. They will scourge you in their
synagogues - In these the Jews held their courts of judicature, about
both civil and ecclesiastical affairs. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 9" id="i.ii.xii-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|24|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.9">Matt. xxiv, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p17">19. Take no thought - Neither at this time, on any sudden
call, need we be careful how or what to answer. <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 11" id="i.ii.xii-p17.1" parsed="|Luke|12|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.11">Luke xii, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p18">21. <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 16" id="i.ii.xii-p18.1" parsed="|Luke|21|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.16">Luke xxi,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p19">22. Of all men - That know not God. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 13" id="i.ii.xii-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|24|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.13">Matt. xxiv, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p20">23. Ye shall not have gone over the cities of Israel - Make
what haste ye will; till the Son of man be come - To destroy their
temple and nation.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p21">24. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 30" id="i.ii.xii-p21.1" parsed="|Luke|6|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.30">Luke vi, 30</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xv. 20" id="i.ii.xii-p21.2" parsed="|John|15|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.15.20">John xv, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p22">25. How much more - This cannot refer to the quantity of
reproach and persecution: (for in this the servant cannot be above his
Lord:) but only to the certainty of it. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 24" id="i.ii.xii-p22.1" parsed="|Matt|12|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.24">Matt. xii, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p23">26. Therefore fear them not - For ye have only the same
usage with your Lord. There is nothing covered - So that however they
may slander you now, your innocence will at length appear. <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 22" id="i.ii.xii-p23.1" parsed="|Mark|4|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.22">Mark iv, 22</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 17; xii. 2" id="i.ii.xii-p23.2" parsed="|Luke|8|17|0|0;|Luke|12|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.17 Bible:Luke.12.2">Luke viii, 17; xii,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p24">27. Even what I now tell you secretly is not to be kept
secret long, but declared publicly. Therefore, What ye hear in the ear,
publish on the house-top - Two customs of the Jews seem to be alluded to
here. Their doctors used to whisper in the ear of their disciples what
they were to pronounce aloud to others. And as their houses were low and
flat roofed, they sometimes preached to the people from thence. <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 3" id="i.ii.xii-p24.1" parsed="|Luke|12|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.3">Luke xii, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p25">28. And be not afraid - of any thing which ye may suffer
for proclaiming it. Be afraid of him who is able to destroy both body
and soul in hell - It is remarkable, that our Lord commands those who
love God, still to fear him, even on this account, under this
notion.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p26">29, 30. The particular providence of God is another reason
for your not fearing man. For this extends to the very smallest things.
And if he has such care over the most inconsiderable creatures, how much
more will he take care of you, (provided you confess him before men,
before powerful enemies of the truth, ) and that not only in this life,
but in the other also?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p27">32. Whosoever shall confess me - Publicly acknowledge me
for the promised Messiah. But this confession implies the receiving his
whole doctrine, <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 38" id="i.ii.xii-p27.1" parsed="|Mark|8|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.38">Mark viii,
38</scripRef>, and obeying all his commandments. <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 26" id="i.ii.xii-p27.2" parsed="|Luke|9|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.26">Luke ix, 26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p28">33, 34. Whosoever shall deny me before men - To which ye
will be strongly tempted. For Think not that I am come - That is, think
not that universal peace will be the immediate consequence of my coming.
Just the contrary. Both public and private divisions will follow,
wheresoever my Gospel comes with power. Ye - this is not the design,
though it be the event of his coming, through the opposition of devils
and men.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p29">36. And the foes of a man - That loves and follows me. <scripRef passage="Micah vii. 6" id="i.ii.xii-p29.1" parsed="|Mic|7|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mic.7.6">Micah vii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p30">37. He that loveth father or mother more than me - He that
is not ready to give up all these, when they stand in competition with
his duty.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p31">38. He that taketh not his cross - That is, whatever pain
or inconvenience cannot be avoided, but by doing some evil, or omitting
some good. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 24" id="i.ii.xii-p31.1" parsed="|Matt|16|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.24">Matt. xvi, 24</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xiv. 27" id="i.ii.xii-p31.2" parsed="|Luke|14|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.14.27">Luke xiv, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p32">39. He that findeth his life shall lose it - He that saves
his life by denying me, shall lose it eternally; and he that loseth his
life by confessing me, shall save it eternally. And as you shall be thus
rewarded, so in proportion shall they who entertain you for my sake. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 25" id="i.ii.xii-p32.1" parsed="|Matt|16|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.25">Matt. xvi, 25</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xii. 25" id="i.ii.xii-p32.2" parsed="|John|12|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.25">John xii, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p33">40. <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 5" id="i.ii.xii-p33.1" parsed="|Matt|18|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.5">Matt. xviii,
5</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke x. 16" id="i.ii.xii-p33.2" parsed="|Luke|10|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.16">Luke x, 16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xiii. 20" id="i.ii.xii-p33.3" parsed="|John|13|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.13.20">John xiii, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p34">41. He that entertaineth a prophet - That is, a preacher of
the Gospel: In the name of a prophet - That is, because he is such,
shall share in his reward.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xii-p35">42. One of these little ones - The very least Christian. <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 41" id="i.ii.xii-p35.1" parsed="|Mark|9|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.41">Mark ix, 41</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="1.65%" prev="i.ii.xii" next="i.ii.xiv" id="i.ii.xiii">
<h3 id="i.ii.xiii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xi" id="i.ii.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.11" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p1">1. In their cities - The other cities of Israel.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p2">2. He sent two of his disciples - Not because he doubted
himself; but to confirm their faith. <scripRef passage="Luke vii. 18" id="i.ii.xiii-p2.1" parsed="|Luke|7|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.7.18">Luke vii, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p3">3. He that is to come - The Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p4">4. Go and tell John the things that ye hear and see - Which
are a stronger proof of my being the Messiah, than any bare assertion
can be.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p5">5. The poor have the Gospel preached to them - The greatest
mercy of all. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxix. 18; xxxv. 5" id="i.ii.xiii-p5.1" parsed="|Isa|29|18|0|0;|Isa|35|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.29.18 Bible:Isa.35.5">Isaiah xxix,
18; xxxv, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p6">6. Happy is he who shall not be offended at me -
Notwithstanding all these proofs that I am the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p7">7. As they departed, he said concerning John - Of whom
probably he would not have said so much when they were present. A reed
shaken by the wind? - No; nothing could ever shake John in the testimony
he gave to the truth. The expression is proverbial.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p8">8. A man clothed in soft, delicate raiment - An effeminate
courtier, accustomed to fawning and flattery? You may expect to find
persons of such a character in palaces; not in a wilderness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p9">9. More than a prophet - For the prophets only pointed me
out afar off; but John was my immediate forerunner.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p10">10. <scripRef passage="Mal. iii. 1" id="i.ii.xiii-p10.1" parsed="|Mal|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mal.3.1">Mal. iii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p11">11. But he that is least in the kingdom of heaven, is
greater than he - Which an ancient author explains thus: - "One perfect
in the law, as John was, is inferior to one who is baptized into the
death of Christ. For this is the kingdom of heaven, even to be buried
with Christ, and to be raised up together with him. John was greater
than all who had been then born of women, but he was cut off before the
kingdom of heaven was given." [He seems to mean, that righteousness,
peace, and joy, which constitute the present inward kingdom of heaven.]
"He was blameless as to that righteousness which is by the law; but he
fell short of those who are perfected by the spirit of life which is in
Christ. Whosoever, therefore, is least in the kingdom of heaven, by
Christian regeneration, is greater than any who has attained only the
righteousness of the law, because the law maketh nothing perfect." It
may farther mean, the least true Christian believer has a more perfect
knowledge of Jesus Christ, of his redemption and kingdom, than John the
Baptist had, who died before the full manifestation of the Gospel.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p12">12. And from the days of John - That is, from the time that
John had fulfilled his ministry, men rush into my kingdom with a
violence like that of those who are taking a city by storm.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p13">13. For all the prophets and the law prophesied until John
- For all that is written in the law and the prophets only foretold as
distant what is now fulfilled. In John the old dispensation expired, and
the new began. <scripRef passage="Luke xvi. 16" id="i.ii.xiii-p13.1" parsed="|Luke|16|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.16.16">Luke xvi,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p14">14. <scripRef passage="Mal. iv. 5" id="i.ii.xiii-p14.1" parsed="|Mal|4|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mal.4.5">Mal. iv,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p15">15. He that hath ears to hear, let him hear - A kind of
proverbial expression; requiring the deepest attention to what is
spoken.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p16">16. This generation - That is, the men of this age. They
are like those froward children of whom their fellows complain, that
they will be pleased no way.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p17">18. John came neither eating nor drinking - In a rigorous
austere way, like Elijah. And they say, He hath a devil - Is melancholy,
from the influence of an evil spirit.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p18">19. The Son of man came eating and drinking - Conversing in
a free, familiar way. Wisdom is justified by her children - That is, my
wisdom herein is acknowledged by those who are truly wise.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p19">20. Then began he to upbraid the cities - It is observable
he had never upbraided them before. Indeed at first they received him
with all gladness, Capernaum in particular.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p20">21. Woe to thee, Chorazin - That is, miserable art thou. For
these are not curses or imprecations, as has been commonly supposed; but
a solemn, compassionate declaration of the misery they were bringing on
themselves. Chorazin and Bethsaida were cities of Galilee, standing by
the lake Gennesareth. Tyre and Sidon were cities of Phenicia, lying on
the sea shore. The inhabitants of them were heathens. <scripRef passage="Luke x. 13" id="i.ii.xiii-p20.1" parsed="|Luke|10|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.13">Luke x, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p21">22, 24. Moreover I say unto you - Beside the general
denunciation of woee to those stubborn unbelievers, the degree of their
misery will be greater than even that of Tyre and Sidon, yea, of
Sodom.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p22">23. Thou Capernaum, who hast been exalted to heaven - That
is, highly honoured by my presence and miracles.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p23">25. Jesus answering - This word does not always imply, that
something had been spoken, to which an answer is now made. It often
means no more than the speaking in reference to some action or
circumstance preceding. The following words Christ speaks in reference
to the case of the cities above mentioned: I thank thee - That is, I
acknowledge and joyfully adore the justice and mercy of thy
dispensations: Because thou hast hid - That is, because thou hast
suffered these things to be hid from men, who are in other respects wise
and prudent, while thou hast discovered them to those of the weakest
understanding, to them who are only wise to Godward. <scripRef passage="Luke x. 21" id="i.ii.xiii-p23.1" parsed="|Luke|10|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.21">Luke x, 21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p24">27. All things are delivered to me - Our Lord, here
addressing himself to his disciples, shows why men, wise in other
things, do not know this: namely, because none can know it by natural
reason: none but those to whom he revealeth it.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p25">28. Come to me - Here he shows to whom he is pleased to
reveal these things to the weary and heavy laden; ye that labour - After
rest in God: and are heavy laden - With the guilt and power of sin: and
I will give you rest - I alone (for none else can) will freely give you
(what ye cannot purchase) rest from the guilt of sin by justification,
and from the power of sin by sanctification.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p26">29. Take my yoke upon you - Believe in me: receive me as
your prophet, priest, and king. For I am meek and lowly in heart - Meek
toward all men, lowly toward God: and ye shall find rest - Whoever
therefore does not find rest of soul, is not meek and lowly. The fault
is not in the yoke of Christ: but in thee, who hast not taken it upon
thee. Nor is it possible for any one to be discontented, but through
want of meekness or lowliness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiii-p27">30. For my yoke is easy - Or rather gracious, sweet,
benign, delightful: and my burden - Contrary to those of men, is ease,
liberty, and honour.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="1.76%" prev="i.ii.xiii" next="i.ii.xv" id="i.ii.xiv">
<h3 id="i.ii.xiv-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xii" id="i.ii.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p1">1. His disciples plucked the ears of corn, and ate - Just
what sufficed for present necessity: dried corn was a common food among
the Jews. <scripRef passage="Mark ii. 23" id="i.ii.xiv-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|2|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2.23">Mark ii, 23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 1" id="i.ii.xiv-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|6|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.1">Luke vi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p2">3. Have ye not read what David did - And necessity was a
sufficient plea for his transgressing the law in a higher instance.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p3">4. He entered into the house of God - Into the tabernacle.
The temple was not yet built. The show bread - So they called the bread
which the priest, who served that week, put every Sabbath day on the
golden table that was in the holy place, before the Lord. The loaves
were twelve in number, and represented the twelve tribes of Israel: when
the new were brought, the stale were taken away, but were to be eaten by
the priests only. <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxi. 6" id="i.ii.xiv-p3.1" parsed="|1Sam|21|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.21.6">1 Sam. xxi, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p4">5. The priests in the temple profane the Sabbath - That is,
do their ordinary work on this, as on a common day, cleansing all
things, and preparing the sacrifices. A greater than the temple - If
therefore the Sabbath must give way to the temple, much more must it
give way to me.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p5">7. I will have mercy and not sacrifice - That is, when they
interfere with each other, I always prefer acts of mercy, before matters
of positive institution: yea, before all ceremonial institutions
whatever; because these being only means of religion, are suspended of
course, if circumstances occur, wherein they clash with love, which is
the end of it. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 13" id="i.ii.xiv-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|9|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.13">Matt. ix,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p6">8. For the Son of man - Therefore they are guiltless, were
it only on this account, that they act by my authority, and attend on me
in my ministry, as the priests attended on God in the temple: is Lord
even of the Sabbath - This certainly implies, that the Sabbath was an
institution of great and distinguished importance; it may perhaps also
refer to that signal act of authority which Christ afterward exerted
over it, in changing it from the seventh to the first day of the week.
If we suppose here is a transposition of the 7th and 8th verses, then
the 8th verse is a proof of the 6th. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 7, 8, 6" id="i.ii.xiv-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|12|7|12|8;|Matt|12|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.7-Matt.12.8 Bible:Matt.12.6">Matt. xii, 7, 8, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p7">9. <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 1" id="i.ii.xiv-p7.1" parsed="|Mark|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.1">Mark iii, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 6" id="i.ii.xiv-p7.2" parsed="|Luke|6|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.6">Luke vi, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p8">12. It is lawful to do good on the Sabbath day - To save a
beast, much more a man.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p9">18. He shall show judgment to the heathens - That is, he
shall publish the merciful Gospel to them also: the Hebrew word
signifies either mercy or justice. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xlii. 1" id="i.ii.xiv-p9.1" parsed="|Isa|42|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.42.1">Isaiah xlii, 1</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p10">19. He shall not strive, nor clamour; neither shall any man
hear his voice in the streets - That is, he shall not be contentious,
noisy, or ostentatious: but gentle, quiet, and lowly. We may observe
each word rises above the other, expressing a still higher degree of
humility and gentleness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p11">20. A bruised reed - A convinced sinner: one that is
bruised with the weight of sin: smoking flax - One that has the least
good desire, the faintest spark of grace: till he send forth judgment
unto victory - That is, till he make righteousness completely victorious
over all its enemies.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p12">21. In his name - That is, in him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p13">22. A demoniac, blind and dumb - Many undoubtedly supposed
these defects to be merely natural. But the Spirit of God saw otherwise,
and gives the true account both of the disorder and the cure. How many
disorders, seemingly natural, may even now be owing to the same cause? <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 14" id="i.ii.xiv-p13.1" parsed="|Luke|11|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.14">Luke xi, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p14">23. Is not this the son of David - That is, the
Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p15">24. <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 22" id="i.ii.xiv-p15.1" parsed="|Mark|3|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.22">Mark iii,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p16">25. Jesus knowing their thoughts - It seems they had as yet
only said it in their hearts.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p17">26. How shall his kingdom be established - Does not that
subtle spirit know this is not the way to establish his kingdom?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p18">27. By whom do your children - That is, disciples, cast
them out - It seems, some of them really did this; although the sons of
Sceva could not. Therefore shall they be your judge - Ask them, if Satan
will cast out Satan: let even them be Judge in this matter. And they
shall convict you of obstinacy and partiality, who impute that in me to
Beelzebub, which in them you impute to God. Beside, how can I rob him of
his subjects, till I have conquered him? The kingdom of God is come upon
you - Unawares; before you expected: so the word implies.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p19">29. How can one enter into the strong one's house, unless
he first bind the strong one - So Christ coming into the world, which
was then eminently the strong one's, Satan's house, first bound him, and
then took his spoils.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p20">30. He that is not with me is against me - For there are no

him; either a loyal subject or a rebel. And there are none upon earth,
who neither promote nor obstruct his kingdom. For he that does not
gather souls to God, scatters them from him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p21">31. The blasphemy against the Spirit - How much stir has
been made about this? How many sermons, yea, volumes, have been written
concerning it? And yet there is nothing plainer in all the Bible. It is
neither more nor less than the ascribing those miracles to the power of
the devil, which Christ wrought by the power of the Holy Ghost. <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 28" id="i.ii.xiv-p21.1" parsed="|Mark|3|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.28">Mark iii, 28</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 10" id="i.ii.xiv-p21.2" parsed="|Luke|12|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.10">Luke xii, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p22">32. Whosoever speaketh against the Son of man - In any
other respects: It shall be forgiven him - Upon his true repentance: But
whosoever speaketh thus against the Holy Ghost, it shall not be
forgiven, neither in this world nor in the world to come - This was a
proverbial expression among the Jews, for a thing that would never be
done. It here means farther, He shall not escape the punishment of it,
either in this world, or in the world to come. The judgment of God shall
overtake him, both here and hereafter.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p23">33. Either make the tree good and its fruit good: or make
the tree corrupt and its fruit corrupt - That is, you must allow, they
are both good, or both bad.- For if the fruit is good, so is the tree;
if the fruit is evil, so is the tree also. For the tree is known by its
fruit - As if he had said, Ye may therefore know me by my fruits. By my
converting sinners to God, you may know that God hath sent me. <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 16" id="i.ii.xiv-p23.1" parsed="|Matt|7|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.16">Matt. vii, 16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 43" id="i.ii.xiv-p23.2" parsed="|Luke|6|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.43">Luke vi, 43</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p24">34. In another kind likewise, the tree is known by its
fruit - Namely, the heart by the conversation.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p25">36. Ye may perhaps think, God does not so much regard your
words. But I say to you - That not for blasphemous and profane words
only, but for every idle word which men shall speak - For want of
seriousness or caution; for every discourse which is not conducive to
the glory of God, they shall give account in the day of judgment.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p26">37. For by thy words (as well as thy tempers and works)
thou shalt then be either acquitted or condemned. - Your words as well
as actions shall be produced in evidence for or against you, to prove
whether you was a true believer or not. And according to that evidence
you will either be acquitted or condemned in the great day.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p27">38. We would see a sign - Else we will not believe this. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 1" id="i.ii.xiv-p27.1" parsed="|Matt|16|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.1">Matt. xvi, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 16, 29" id="i.ii.xiv-p27.2" parsed="|Luke|11|16|0|0;|Luke|11|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.16 Bible:Luke.11.29">Luke xi,
16, 29</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p28">39. An adulterous generation - Whose heart wanders from
God, though they profess him to be their husband. Such adulterers are
all those who love the world, and all who seek the friendship of it.
Seeketh a sign - After all they have had already, which were abundantly
sufficient to convince them, had not their hearts been estranged from
God, and consequently averse to the truth. The sign of Jonah - Who was
herein a type of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p29">40. Three days and three nights - It was customary with the
eastern nations to reckon any part of a natural day of twenty-four
hours, for the whole day. Accordingly they used to say a thing was done
after three or seven days, if it was done on the third or seventh day,
from that which was last mentioned. Instances of this may be seen, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xx. 29" id="i.ii.xiv-p29.1" parsed="|1Kgs|20|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.20.29">1 Kings xx, 29</scripRef>; and in many other places. And as the Hebrews had no word to
express a natural day, they used night and day, or day and night for it.
So that to say a thing happened after three days and three nights, was
with them the very same, as to say, it happened after three days, or on
the third day. See <scripRef passage="Esther iv. 16; v. 1" id="i.ii.xiv-p29.2" parsed="|Esth|4|16|0|0;|Esth|5|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.4.16 Bible:Esth.5.1">Esther iv, 16; v, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Gen. vii. 4, 12" id="i.ii.xiv-p29.3" parsed="|Gen|7|4|0|0;|Gen|7|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.7.4 Bible:Gen.7.12">Gen. vii, 4, 12</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiv. 18; xxxiv. 28" id="i.ii.xiv-p29.4" parsed="|Exod|24|18|0|0;|Exod|34|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.24.18 Bible:Exod.34.28">Exod. xxiv, 18; xxxiv,
28</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Jonah ii. 1" id="i.ii.xiv-p29.5" parsed="|Jonah|2|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jonah.2.1">Jonah ii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p30">42. She came from the uttermost parts of the earth - That
part of Arabia from which she came was the uttermost part of the earth
that way, being bounded by the sea. <scripRef passage="1 Kings x. 1" id="i.ii.xiv-p30.1" parsed="|1Kgs|10|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.10.1">1
Kings x, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p31">43. But how dreadful will be the consequence of their
rejecting me? When the unclean spirit goeth out - Not willingly, but
being compelled by one that is stronger than he. He walketh - Wanders up
and down; through dry places - Barren, dreary, desolate; or places not
yet watered with the Gospel: Seeking rest, and findeth none - How can
he, while he carries with him his own hell? And is it not the case of
his children too? Reader, is it thy case? <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 24" id="i.ii.xiv-p31.1" parsed="|Luke|11|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.24">Luke xi, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p32">44. Whence he came out - He speaks as if he had come out of
his own accord: See his pride! He findeth it empty - of God, of Christ,
of his Spirit: Swept - from love, lowliness, meekness, and all the
fruits of the Spirit: And garnished - With levity and security: so that
there is nothing to keep him out, and much to invite him in.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p33">45. Seven other spirits - That is, a great many; a certain
number being put for an uncertain: More wicked than himself - Whence it
appears, that there are degrees of wickedness among the devils
themselves: They enter in and dwell - For ever in him who is forsaken of
God. So shall it be to this wicked generation - Yea, and to apostates in
all ages.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p34">46. His brethren -- his kinsmen: they were the sons of Mary,
the wife of Cleopas, or Alpheus, his mother's sister; and came now
seeking to take him, as one beside himself, <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 21" id="i.ii.xiv-p34.1" parsed="|Mark|3|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.21">Mark iii, 21</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 31" id="i.ii.xiv-p34.2" parsed="|Mark|3|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.31">Mark iii, 31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 19" id="i.ii.xiv-p34.3" parsed="|Luke|8|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.19">Luke
viii, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p35">48. And he answering, said - Our Lord's knowing why they
came, sufficiently justifies his seeming disregard of them.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xiv-p36">49, 50. See the highest severity, and the highest goodness!
Severity to his natural, goodness to his spiritual relations! In a
manner disclaiming the former, who opposed the will of his heavenly
Father, and owning the latter, who obeyed it.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="1.93%" prev="i.ii.xiv" next="i.ii.xvi" id="i.ii.xv">
<h3 id="i.ii.xv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xiii" id="i.ii.xv-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xv-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 1" id="i.ii.xv-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|4|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.1">Mark iv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 4" id="i.ii.xv-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|8|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.4">Luke viii, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p2">2. He went into the vessel - Which constantly waited upon
him, while he was on the sea coast.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p3">3. In parables - The word is here taken in its proper
sense, for apt similes or comparisons. This way of speaking, extremely
common in the eastern countries, drew and fixed the attention of many,
and occasioned the truths delivered to sink the deeper into humble and
serious hearers. At the same time, by an awful mixture of justice and
mercy, it hid them from the proud and careless. In this chapter our Lord
delivers seven parables; directing the four former (as being of general
concern) to all the people; the three latter to his disciples. Behold
the sower - How exquisitely proper is this parable to be an introduction
to all the rest! In this our Lord answers a very obvious and a very
important question. The same sower, Christ, and the same preachers sent
by him, always sow the same seed: why has it not always the same effect?
He that hath ears to hear, let him hear!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p4">4. And while he sowed, some seeds fell by the highway side,
and the birds came and devoured them - It is observable, that our Lord
points out the grand hindrances of our bearing fruit, in the same order
as they occur. The first danger is, that the birds will devour the seed.
If it escape this, there is then another danger, namely, lest it be
scorched, and wither away. It is long after this that the thorns spring
up and choke the good seed. A vast majority of those who hear the word
of God, receive the seed as by the highway side. Of those who do not
lose it by the birds, yet many receive it as on stony places. Many of
them who receive it in a better soil, yet suffer the thorns to grow up,
and choke it: so that few even of these endure to the end, and bear
fruit unto perfection: yet in all these cases, it is not the will of God
that hinders, but their own voluntary perverseness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p5">8. Good ground - Soft, not like that by the highway side;
deep, not like the stony ground; purged, not full of thorns.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p6">11. To you, who have, it is given to know the mysteries of
the kingdom of heaven - The deep things which flesh and blood cannot
reveal, pertaining to the inward, present kingdom of heaven. But to them
who have not, it is not given - Therefore speak I in parables, that ye
may understand, while they do not understand.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p7">12. Whosoever hath - That is, improves what he hath, uses
the grace given according to the design of the giver; to him shall be
given - More and more, in proportion to that improvement. But whosoever
hath not - Improves it not, from him shall be taken even what he hath -
Here is the grand rule of God's dealing with the children of men: a rule
fixed as the pillars of heaven. This is the key to all his providential
dispensations; as will appear to men and angels in that day. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxv. 29" id="i.ii.xv-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|25|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.25.29">Matt. xxv, 29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 25" id="i.ii.xv-p7.2" parsed="|Mark|4|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.25">Mark iv, 25</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 18; xix. 26" id="i.ii.xv-p7.3" parsed="|Luke|8|18|0|0;|Luke|19|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.18 Bible:Luke.19.26">Luke viii, 18; xix,
26.</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p8">13. Therefore I speak to them in parables, because seeing,
they see not - In pursuance of this general rule, I do not give more
knowledge to this people, be. cause they use not that which they have
already: having all the means of seeing, hearing, and understanding,
they use none of them: they do not effectually see, or hear, or
understand any thing.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p9">14. Hearing ye will hear, but in nowise understand - That
is, Ye will surely hear. All possible means will be given you: yet they
will profit you nothing; because your heart is sensual, stupid, and
insensible; your spiritual senses are shut up; yea, you have closed your
eyes against the light; as being unwilling to understand the things of
God, and afraid, not desirous that he should heal you. <scripRef passage="Isaiah vi. 9" id="i.ii.xv-p9.1" parsed="|Isa|6|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.6.9">Isaiah vi, 9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xii. 40" id="i.ii.xv-p9.2" parsed="|John|12|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.40">John xii, 40</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Acts xxviii. 26" id="i.ii.xv-p9.3" parsed="|Acts|28|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.28.26">Acts xxviii, 26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p10">16. But blessed are your eyes - For you both see and
understand. You know how to prize the light which is given you. <scripRef passage="Luke x. 23" id="i.ii.xv-p10.1" parsed="|Luke|10|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.23">Luke x, 23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p11">19. When any one heareth the word, and considereth it not -
The first and most general cause of unfruitfulness. The wicked one
cometh - Either inwardly; filling the mind with thoughts of other
things; or by his agent. Such are all they that introduce other
subjects, when men should be considering what they have heard.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p12">20. The seed sown on stony places, therefore sprang up
soon, because it did not sink deep, ver. 5. He receiveth it with joy -
Perhaps with transport, with ecstasy: struck with the beauty of truth,
and drawn by the preventing grace of God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p13">21. Yet hath he not root in himself - No deep work of
grace: no change in the ground of his heart. Nay, he has no deep
conviction; and without this, good desires soon wither away. He is
offended - He finds a thousand plausible pretenses for leaving so narrow
and rugged a way.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p14">22. He that received the seed among the thorns, is he that
heareth the word and considereth it - In spite of Satan and his agents:
yea, hath root in himself is deeply convinced, and in a great measure
inwardly changed; so that he will not draw back, even when tribulation
or persecution ariseth. And yet even in him, together with the good
seed, the thorns spring up, ver. 7. (perhaps unperceived at first) till
they gradually choke it, destroy all its life and power, and it becometh
unfruitful. Cares are thorns to the poor: wealth to the rich; the desire
of other things to all. The deceitfulness of riches - Deceitful indeed!
for they smile, and betray: kiss, and smite into hell. They put out the
eyes, harden the heart, steal away all the life of God; fill the soul
with pride, anger, love of the world; make men enemies to the whole
cross of Christ! And all the while are eagerly desired, and vehemently
pursued, even by those who believe there is a God!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p15">23. Some a hundred fold, some sixty, some thirty - That is,
in various proportions; some abundantly more than others.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p16">24. He proposed another parable - in which he farther
explains the case of unfruitful hearers. The kingdom of heaven (as has
been observed before) sometimes signifies eternal glory: sometimes the
way to it, inward religion; sometimes, as here, the Gospel dispensation:
the phrase is likewise used for a person or thing relating to any one of
those: so in this place it means, Christ preaching the Gospel, who is
like a man sowing good seed - The expression, is like, both here and in
several other places, only means, that the thing spoken of may be
illustrated by the following similitude. Who sowed good seed in his
field - God sowed nothing but good in his whole creation. Christ sowed
only the good seed of truth in his Church.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p17">25. But while men slept - They ought to have watched: the
Lord of the field sleepeth not. His enemy came and sowed darnel - This
is very like wheat, and commonly grows among wheat rather than among
other grain: but tares or vetches are of the pulse kind, and bear no
resemblance to wheat.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p18">26. When the blade was sprung up, then appeared the darnel
- It was not discerned before: it seldom appears, as soon as the good
seed is sown: all at first appears to be peace, and love, and joy.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p19">27. Didst not thou sow good seed in thy field? Whence then
hath it darnel? - Not from the parent of good. Even the heathen could
say, "No evil can from thee proceed: 'Tis only suffer'd, not decreed: As
darkness is not from the sun, Nor mount the shades, till he is
gone."</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p20">28. He said, An enemy hath done this - A plain answer to
the great question concerning the origin of evil. God made men (as he
did angels) intelligent creatures, and consequently free either to
choose good or evil: but he implanted no evil in the human soul: An
enemy (with man's concurrence) hath done this. Darnel, in the Church, is
properly outside Christians, such as have the form of godliness, without
the power. Open sinners, such as have neither the form nor the power,
are not so properly darnel, as thistles and brambles: these ought to be
rooted up without delay, and not suffered in the Christian community.
Whereas should fallible men attempt to gather up the darnel, they would
often root up the wheat with them.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p21">31. He proposed to them another parable - The former
parables relate chiefly to unfruitful hearers; these that follow, to
those who bear good fruit. The kingdom of heaven - Both the Gospel
dispensation, and the inward kingdom. <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 30" id="i.ii.xv-p21.1" parsed="|Mark|4|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.30">Mark iv, 30</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xiii. 18" id="i.ii.xv-p21.2" parsed="|Luke|13|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13.18">Luke xiii, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p22">32. The least - That is, one of the least: a way of
speaking extremely common among the Jews. It becometh a tree - In those
countries it grows exceeding large and high. So will the Christian
doctrine spread in the world, and the life of Christ in the soul.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p23">33. Three measures - This was the quantity which they
usually baked at once: till the whole was leavened - Thus will the
Gospel leaven the world and grace the Christian. <scripRef passage="Luke xiii. 20" id="i.ii.xv-p23.1" parsed="|Luke|13|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13.20">Luke xiii, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p24">34. Without a parable spake he not unto them - That is, not
at that time; at other times he did.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p25">35. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxviii. 2" id="i.ii.xv-p25.1" parsed="|Ps|78|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.78.2">Psalm lxxviii,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p26">38. The good seed are the children of the kingdom - That
is, the children of God, the righteous.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p27">41. They shall gather all things that offend - Whatever had
hindered or grieved the children of God; whatever things or persons had
hindered the good seed which Christ had sown from taking root or bearing
fruit. The Greek word is, All scandals.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p28">44. The three following parables are proposed, not to the
multitude, but peculiarly to the apostles: the two former of them relate
to those who receive the Gospel; the third, both to those who receive,
and those who preach it. The kingdom of heaven is like treasure hid in a
field - The kingdom of God within us is a treasure indeed, but a
treasure hid from the world, and from the most wise and prudent in it.
He that finds this treasure, (perhaps when he thought it far from him, )
hides it deep in his heart, and gives up all other happiness for it.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p29">45. The kingdom of heaven - That is, one who earnestly
seeks for it: in verse 47 it means, the Gospel preached, which is like a
net gathering of every kind: just so the Gospel, wherever it is
preached, gathers at first both good and bad, who are for a season full
of approbation and warm with good desires. But Christian discipline, and
strong, close exhortation, begin that separation in this world, which
shall be accomplished by the angels of God in the world to come.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p30">52. Every scribe instructed unto the kingdom of heaven -
That is, every duly prepared preacher of the Gospel has a treasure of
Divine knowledge, out of which he is able to bring forth all sorts of
instructions. The word treasure signifies any collection of things
whatsoever, and the places where such collections are kept.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p31">53. He departed thence - He crossed the lake from
Capernaum: and came once more into his own country - Nazareth: but with
no better success than he had had there before.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p32">54. Whence hath HE - Many texts are not understood, for
want of knowing the proper emphasis; and others are utterly
misunderstood, by placing the emphasis wrong. To prevent this in some
measure, the emphatical words are here printed in capital letters. <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 1" id="i.ii.xv-p32.1" parsed="|Mark|6|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.1">Mark vi, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 16, 22" id="i.ii.xv-p32.2" parsed="|Luke|4|16|0|0;|Luke|4|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.16 Bible:Luke.4.22">Luke iv, 16, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p33">55. The carpenter's son - The Greek, word means, one that
works either in wood, iron, or stone. His brethren -- our kinsmen. They
were the sons of Mary, sister to the virgin, and wife of Cleophas or
Alpheus. James - Styled by St. Paul also, the Lord's brother, <scripRef passage="Gal. i. 19" id="i.ii.xv-p33.1" parsed="|Gal|1|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.1.19">Gal. i, 19</scripRef>. Simon - Surnamed the Canaanite.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p34">57. They were offended at him - They looked on him as a
mean, ignoble man, not worthy to be regarded. <scripRef passage="John iv. 44" id="i.ii.xv-p34.1" parsed="|John|4|44|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.4.44">John iv, 44</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vii. 23" id="i.ii.xv-p34.2" parsed="|Luke|7|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.7.23">Luke vii, 23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xv-p35">58. He wrought not many mighty works, because of their
unbelief - And the reason why many mighty works are not wrought now, is
not, that the faith is not everywhere planted; but, that unbelief every
where prevails.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="2.13%" prev="i.ii.xv" next="i.ii.xvii" id="i.ii.xvi">
<h3 id="i.ii.xvi-p0.1">XIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xiv" id="i.ii.xvi-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p1">1. At that time - When our Lord had spent about a year in
his public ministry. Tetrarch - King of a fourth part of his father's
dominions. <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 14" id="i.ii.xvi-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|6|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.14">Mark vi, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p2">2. He is risen from the dead - Herod was a Sadducee: and
the Sadducees denied the resurrection of the dead. But Sadduceeism
staggers when conscience awakes.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p3">3. His brother Philip's wife - Who was still alive. <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 17" id="i.ii.xvi-p3.1" parsed="|Mark|6|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.17">Mark vi, 17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p4">4. It is not lawful for thee to have her - It was not
lawful indeed for either of them to have her. For her father Aristobulus
was their own brother. John's words were rough, like his raiment. He
would not break the force of truth by using soft words, even to a
king.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p5">5. He would have put him to death - ln his fit of passion;
but he was then restrained by fear of the multitude; and afterward by
the reverence he bore him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p6">6. The daughter of Herodias - Afterward infamous for a life
suitable to this beginning.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p7">8. Being before instructed by her mother - Both as to the
matter and manner of her petition: She said, Give me here - Fearing if
he had time to consider, he would not do it: John the Baptist's head in
a charger - A large dish or bowl.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p8">9. And the king was sorry - Knowing that John was a good
man. Yet for the oath's sake - So he murdered an innocent man from mere
tenderness of conscience.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p9">10. And he sent and beheaded John in the prison, and his
head was given to the damsel - How mysterious is the providence, which
left the life of so holy a man in such infamous hands! which permitted
it to be sacrificed to the malice of an abandoned harlot, the petulancy
of a vain girl, and the rashness of a foolish, perhaps drunken prince,
who made a prophet's head the reward of a dance! But we are sure the
Almighty will repay his servants in another world for whatever they
suffer in this.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p10">13. Jesus withdrew into a desert place -</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xvi-p11">1. To avoid Herod:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xvi-p12">2. Because of the multitude pressing upon
him, <scripRef passage="Mark vi. xxxii" id="i.ii.xvi-p12.1" parsed="|Mark|6|0|0|0;|Mark|32|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6 Bible:Mark.32">Mark vi, xxxii</scripRef>, and</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xvi-p13">3. To talk with his disciples, newly returned
from their progress, Luke ix, x, apart - From all but his disciples. <scripRef passage="John vi. 1" id="i.ii.xvi-p13.1" parsed="|John|6|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.6.1">John vi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p14">15. The time is now past - The usual meal time. <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 35" id="i.ii.xvi-p14.1" parsed="|Mark|6|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.35">Mark vi, 35</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 12" id="i.ii.xvi-p14.2" parsed="|Luke|9|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.12">Luke ix, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p15">22. He constrained his disciples - Who were unwilling to
leave him. <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 45" id="i.ii.xvi-p15.1" parsed="|Mark|6|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.45">Mark vi, 45</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John vi. 15" id="i.ii.xvi-p15.2" parsed="|John|6|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.6.15">John vi, 15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p16">24. In the evening - Learned men say the Jews reckoned two
evenings; the first beginning at three in the afternoon, the second, at
sunset. If so, the latter is meant here.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p17">25. The fourth watch - The Jews (as well as the Romans)
usually divided the night into four watches, of three hours each. The
first watch began at six, the second at nine, the third at twelve, the
fourth at three in the morning. If it be thou - It is the same as, Since
it is thou. The particle if frequently bears this meaning, both in ours
and in all languages. So it means, <scripRef passage="John xiii. 14, 17" id="i.ii.xvi-p17.1" parsed="|John|13|14|0|0;|John|13|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.13.14 Bible:John.13.17">John xiii, 14, 17</scripRef>. St. Peter was in no doubt, or he would not have quitted the
ship.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p18">30. He was afraid - Though he had been used to the sea, and
was a skilful swimmer. But so it frequently is. When grace begins to
act, the natural courage and strength are withdrawn.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p19">33. Thou art the Son of God - They mean, the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvi-p20">35. <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 45" id="i.ii.xvi-p20.1" parsed="|Mark|6|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.45">Mark vi,
45</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="2.19%" prev="i.ii.xvi" next="i.ii.xviii" id="i.ii.xvii">
<h3 id="i.ii.xvii-p0.1">XV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xv" id="i.ii.xvii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.15" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Mark vii. 1" id="i.ii.xvii-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.7.1">Mark vii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p2">2. The elders - The chief doctors or, teachers among the
Jews.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p3">3. They wash not their hands when they eat bread - Food in
general is termed bread in Hebrew; so that to eat bread is the same as
to make a meal.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p4">4. honour thy father and mother - Which implies all such
relief as they stand in need of. <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 12; xxi. 17" id="i.ii.xvii-p4.1" parsed="|Exod|20|12|0|0;|Exod|21|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.12 Bible:Exod.21.17">Exod. xx, 12; xxi,
17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p5">5. It is a gift by whatsoever thou mightest have been
profited by me - That is, I have given, or at least, purpose to give to
the treasury of the temple, what you might otherwise have had from
me.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p6">7. Well did Isaiah prophesy of you, saying - That is, the
description which Isaiah gave of your fathers, is exactly applicable to
you. The words therefore which were a description of them, are a
prophecy with regard to you.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p7">8. Their heart is far from me - And without this all
outward worship is mere mockery of God. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxix. 13" id="i.ii.xvii-p7.1" parsed="|Isa|29|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.29.13">Isaiah xxix, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p8">9. Teaching the commandments of men - As equal with, nay,
superior to, those of God. What can be a more heinous sin?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p9">13. Every plant - That is, every doctrine.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p10">14. Let them alone - If they are indeed blind leaders of
the blind; let them alone: concern not yourselves about them: a plain
direction how to behave with regard to all such. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 39" id="i.ii.xvii-p10.1" parsed="|Luke|6|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.39">Luke vi, 39</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p11">17. Are ye also yet without understanding - How fair and
candid are the sacred historians? Never concealing or excusing their own
blemishes.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p12">19. First evil thoughts - then murders - and the rest.
Railings - The Greek word includes all reviling, backbiting, and evil
speaking.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p13">21. <scripRef passage="Mark vii. 24" id="i.ii.xvii-p13.1" parsed="|Mark|7|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.7.24">Mark vii,
24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p14">22. A woman of Canaan - Canaan was also called
Syrophenicia, as lying between Syria properly so called, and Phenicia,
by the sea side. Cried to him - From afar, Thou Son of David - So she
had some knowledge of the promised Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p15">23. He answered her not a word - He sometimes tries our
faith in like manner.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p16">24. I am not sent - Not primarily; not yet.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p17">25. Then came she - Into the house where he now was.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p18">28. Thy faith - Thy reliance on the power and goodness of
God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p19">29. The sea of Galilee - The Jews gave the name of seas to
all large lakes. This was a hundred furlongs long, and forty broad. It
was called also, the sea of Tiberias. It lay on the borders of Galilee,
and the city of Tiberias stood on its western shore. It was likewise
styled the lake of Gennesareth: perhaps a corruption of Cinnereth, the
name by which it was anciently called, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxiv. 11" id="i.ii.xvii-p19.1" parsed="|Num|34|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.34.11">Num. xxxiv, 11</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Mark vii. 31" id="i.ii.xvii-p19.2" parsed="|Mark|7|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.7.31">Mark vii, 31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p20">32. They continue with me now three days - It was now the
third day since they came. <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 1" id="i.ii.xvii-p20.1" parsed="|Mark|8|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.1">Mark viii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xvii-p21">36. He gave thanks, or blessed the food - That is, he
praised God for it, and prayed for a blessing upon it.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="2.23%" prev="i.ii.xvii" next="i.ii.xix" id="i.ii.xviii">
<h3 id="i.ii.xviii-p0.1">XVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xvi" id="i.ii.xviii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p1">1. A sign from heaven - Such they imagined Satan could not
counterfeit. <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 11" id="i.ii.xviii-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|8|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.11">Mark viii, 11</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 38" id="i.ii.xviii-p1.2" parsed="|Matt|12|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.38">Matt. xii, 38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p2">2. <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 54" id="i.ii.xviii-p2.1" parsed="|Luke|12|54|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.54">Luke xii,
54</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p3">3. The signs of the times - The signs which evidently show,
that this is the time of the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p4">4. A wicked and adulterous generation - Ye would seek no
further sign, did not your wickedness, your love of the world, which is
spiritual adultery, blind your understanding.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p5">5. <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 14" id="i.ii.xviii-p5.1" parsed="|Mark|8|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.14">Mark viii,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p6">6. Beware of the leaven of the Pharisees - That is, of
their false doctrine: this is elegantly so called; for it spreads in the
soul, or the Church, as leaven does in meal. <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 1" id="i.ii.xviii-p6.1" parsed="|Luke|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.1">Luke xii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p7">7. They reasoned among themselves - What must we do then
for bread, since we have taken no bread with us?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p8">8. Why reason ye - Why are you troubled about this? Am I
not able, if need so require, to supply you by a word?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p9">11. How do ye not understand - Beside, do you not
understand, that I did not mean bread, by the leaven of the Pharisees
and Sadducees?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p10">13. And Jesus coming - There was a large interval of time
between what has been related, and what follows. The passages that
follow were but a short time before our Lord suffered. <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 27" id="i.ii.xviii-p10.1" parsed="|Mark|8|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.27">Mark viii, 27</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 18" id="i.ii.xviii-p10.2" parsed="|Luke|9|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.18">Luke
ix, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p11">14. Jeremiah, or one of the prophets - There was at that
time a current tradition among the Jews, that either Jeremiah, or some
other of the ancient prophets would rise again before the Messiah
came.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p12">16. Peter - Who was generally the most forward to
speak.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p13">17. Flesh and blood - That is, thy own reason, or any
natural power whatsoever.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p14">18. On this rock - Alluding to his name, which signifies a
rock, namely, the faith which thou hast now professed; I will build my
Church - But perhaps when our Lord uttered these words, he pointed to
himself, in like manner as when he said, Destroy this temple, <scripRef passage="John ii. 19" id="i.ii.xviii-p14.1" parsed="|John|2|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.2.19">John ii, 19</scripRef>; meaning the temple of his body. And it is certain, that as
he is spoken of in Scripture, as the only foundation of the Church, so
this is that which the apostles and evangelists laid in their preaching.
It is in respect of laying this, that the names of the twelve apostles
(not of St. Peter only) were equally inscribed on the twelve foundations
of the city of God, <scripRef passage="Rev. xxi. 14" id="i.ii.xviii-p14.2" parsed="|Rev|21|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.21.14">Rev. xxi, 14</scripRef>. The gates of hell - As gates and walls were the strength of
cities, and as courts of judicature were held in their gates, this
phrase properly signifies the power and policy of Satan and his
instruments. Shall not prevail against it - Not against the Church
universal, so as to destroy it. And they never did. There hath been a
small remnant in all ages.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p15">19. I will give thee the keys of the kingdom of heaven -
Indeed not to him alone, (for they were equally given to all the
apostles at the same time, <scripRef passage="John xx. 21, 22, 23" id="i.ii.xviii-p15.1" parsed="|John|20|21|20|23" osisRef="Bible:John.20.21-John.20.23">John
xx, 21, 22, 23</scripRef>;) but to him were first given the keys both of doctrine and
discipline. He first, after our Lord's resurrection, exercised the
apostleship, <scripRef passage="Acts i. 15" id="i.ii.xviii-p15.2" parsed="|Acts|1|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1.15">Acts i,
15</scripRef>. And he first by preaching opened the kingdom of heaven,
both to the Jews, Acts ii, , and to the Gentiles, Acts x, . Under the
term of binding and loosing are contained all those acts of discipline
which Peter and his brethren performed as apostles: and undoubtedly what
they thus performed on earth, God confirmed in heaven. <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 18" id="i.ii.xviii-p15.3" parsed="|Matt|18|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.18">Matt. xviii, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p16">20. Then charged he his disciples to tell no one that he
was the Christ.  Jesus himself had not said it expressly even to his
apostles, but left them to infer it from his doctrine and miracles.
Neither was it proper the apostles should say this openly, before that
grand proof of it, his resurrection. If they had, they who believed them
would the more earnestly have sought to take and make him a king: and
they who did not believe them would the more vehemently have rejected
and opposed such a Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p17">21. From that time Jesus began to tell his disciples, that
he must suffer many things - Perhaps this expression, began, always
implied his entering on a set and solemn discourse. Hitherto he had
mainly taught them only one point, That he was the Christ. From this
time he taught them another, That Christ must through sufferings and
death enter into his glory. From the elders - The most honourable and
experienced men; the chief priests - Accounted the most religious; and
the scribes - The most learned body of men in the nation. Would not one
have expected, that these should have been the very first to receive
him? But not many wise, not many noble were called. favour thyself - The
advice of the world, the flesh, and the devil, to every one of our
Lord's followers. <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 31" id="i.ii.xviii-p17.1" parsed="|Mark|8|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.31">Mark viii,
31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 22" id="i.ii.xviii-p17.2" parsed="|Luke|9|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.22">Luke ix,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p18">23. Get thee behind me - Out of my sight. It is not
improbable, Peter might step before him, to stop him. Satan - Our Lord
is not recorded to have given so sharp a reproof to any other of his
apostles on any occasion. He saw it was needful for the pride of Peter's
heart, puffed up with the commendation lately given him. Perhaps the
term Satan may not barely mean, Thou art my enemy, while thou fanciest
thyself most my friend; but also, Thou art acting the very part of
Satan, both by endeavouring to hinder the redemption of mankind, and by
giving me the most deadly advice that can ever spring from the pit of
hell. Thou savourest not - Dost not relish or desire. We may learn from
hence,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xviii-p19">1. That whosoever says to us in such a case,
favour thyself, is acting the part of the devil:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xviii-p20">2. That the proper answer to such an adviser
is, Get thee behind me:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xviii-p21">3. That otherwise he will be an offense to
us, an occasion of our stumbling, if not falling:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xviii-p22">4. That this advice always proceeds from the
not relishing the things of God, but the things of men. Yea, so far is
this advice, favour thyself, from being fit for a Christian either to
give or take, that if any man will come after Christ, his very first
step is to deny, or renounce himself: in the room of his own will, to
substitute the will of God, as his one principle of action.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p23">24. If any man be willing to come after me - None is
forced; but if any will be a Christian, it must be on these terms, Let
him deny himself, and take up his cross - A rule that can never be too
much observed: let him in all things deny his own will, however
pleasing, and do the will of God, however painful. Should we not
consider all crosses, all things grievous to flesh and blood, as what
they really are, as opportunities of embracing God's will at the expense
of our own? And consequently as so many steps by which we may advance
toward perfection? We should make a swift progress in the spiritual
life, if we were faithful in this practice. Crosses are so frequent,
that whoever makes advantage of them, will soon be a great gainer. Great
crosses are occasions of great improvement: and the little ones, which
come daily, and even hourly, make up in number what they want in weight.
We may in these daily and hourly crosses make effectual oblations of our
will to God; which oblations, so frequently repeated, will soon amount
to a great sum. Let us remember then (what can never be sufficiently
inculcated) that God is the author of all events: that none is so small
or inconsiderable, as to escape his notice and direction. Every event
therefore declares to us the will of God, to which thus declared we
should heartily submit. We should renounce our own to embrace it; we
should approve and choose what his choice warrants as best for us.
Herein should we exercise ourselves continually; this should be our
practice all the day long. We should in humility accept the little
crosses that are dispensed to us, as those that best suit our weakness.
Let us bear these little things, at least for God's sake, and prefer his
will to our own in matters of so small importance. And his goodness will
accept these mean oblations; for he despiseth not the day of small
things. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 38" id="i.ii.xviii-p23.1" parsed="|Matt|10|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.38">Matt. x, 38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p24">25. Whosoever will save his life - At the expense of his
conscience: whosoever, in the very highest instance, that of life
itself, will not renounce himself, shall be lost eternally. But can any
man hope he should be able thus to renounce himself, if he cannot do it
in the smallest instances? And whosoever will lose his life shall find
it - What he loses on earth he shall find in heaven. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 39" id="i.ii.xviii-p24.1" parsed="|Matt|10|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.39">Matt. x, 39</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 35" id="i.ii.xviii-p24.2" parsed="|Mark|8|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.35">Mark viii, 35</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 24; xvii. 33" id="i.ii.xviii-p24.3" parsed="|Luke|9|24|0|0;|Luke|17|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.24 Bible:Luke.17.33">Luke ix, 24; xvii,
33</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xii. 25" id="i.ii.xviii-p24.4" parsed="|John|12|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.25">John xii, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p25">27. For the Son of man shall come - For there is no way to
escape the righteous judgment of God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xviii-p26">28. And as an emblem of this, there are some here who shall
live to see the Messiah coming to set up his mediatorial kingdom, with
great power and glory, by the increase of his Church, and the
destruction of the temple, city, and polity of the Jews.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="2.39%" prev="i.ii.xviii" next="i.ii.xx" id="i.ii.xix">
<h3 id="i.ii.xix-p0.1">XVII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xvii" id="i.ii.xix-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xix-p1">1. A high mountain - Probably Mount Tabor. <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 2" id="i.ii.xix-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|9|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.2">Mark ix, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 28" id="i.ii.xix-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|9|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.28">Luke ix, 28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p2">2. And was transfigured - Or transformed. The indwelling
Deity darted out its rays through the veil of the flesh; and that with
such transcendent splendour, that he no longer bore the form of a
servant. His face shone with Divine majesty, like the sun in its
strength; and all his body was so irradiated by it, that his clothes
could not conceal its glory, but became white and glittering as the very
light, with which he covered himself as with a garment.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p3">3. There appeared Moses and Elijah - Here for the full
confirmation of their faith in Jesus, Moses, the giver of the law,
Elijah, the most zealous of all the prophets, and God speaking from
heaven, all bore witness to him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p4">4. Let us make three tents - The words of rapturous
surprise. He says three, not six: because the apostles desired to be
with their Master.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p5">5. Hear ye him - As superior even to Moses and the
prophets. See <scripRef passage="Deut. xviii. 17" id="i.ii.xix-p5.1" parsed="|Deut|18|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.18.17">Deut. xviii,
17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p6">7. Be not afraid - And doubtless the same moment he gave
them courage and strength.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p7">9. Tell the vision to no man - Not to the rest of the
disciples, lest they should be grieved and discouraged because they were
not admitted to the sight: nor to any other persons, lest it should
enrage some the more, and his approaching sufferings shall make others
disbelieve it; till the Son of man be risen again - Till the
resurrection should make it credible, and confirm their testimony about
it.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p8">10. Why then say the scribes, that Elijah must come first -
Before the Messiah? If no man is to know of his coming? Should we not
rather tell every man, that he is come, and that we have seen him,
witnessing to thee as the Messiah?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p9">11. Regulate all things - In order to the coming of
Christ.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p10">12. Elijah is come already - And yet when the Jews asked
John, Art thou Elijah? He said, I am not, <scripRef passage="John i. 21" id="i.ii.xix-p10.1" parsed="|John|1|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.21">John i, 21</scripRef>. His meaning was, I am not Elijah the Tishbite, come again
into the world. But he was the person of whom Malachi prophesied under
that name.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p11">14. <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 14" id="i.ii.xix-p11.1" parsed="|Mark|9|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.14">Mark ix, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 37" id="i.ii.xix-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|11|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.37">Luke xi, 37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p12">15. He is lunatic - This word might with great propriety he
used, though the case was mostly preternatural; as the evil spirit would
undoubtedly take advantage of the influence which the changes of the
moon have on the brain and nerves.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p13">17. O unbelieving and perverse generation - Our Lord speaks
principally this to his disciples. How long shall I be with you? -
Before you steadfastly believe?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p14">20. Because of your unbelief - Because in this particular
they had not faith. If ye have faith as a grain of mustard seed - That
is, the least measure of it. But it is certain, the faith which is here
spoken of does not always imply saving faith. Many have had it who
thereby cast out devils, and yet will at last have their portion with
them. It is only a supernatural persuasion given a man, that God will
work thus by him at that hour. Now, though I have all this faith so as
to remove mountains, yet if I have not the faith which worketh by love,
I am nothing. To remove mountains was a proverbial phrase among the
Jews, and is still retained in their writings, to express a thing which
is very difficult, and to appearance impossible. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 21" id="i.ii.xix-p14.1" parsed="|Matt|21|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.21">Matt. xxi, 21</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xvii. 6" id="i.ii.xix-p14.2" parsed="|Luke|17|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17.6">Luke xvii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p15">21. This kind of devils - goeth not out but by prayer and
fasting - What a testimony is here of the efficacy of fasting, when
added to fervent prayer! Some kinds of devils the apostles had cast out
before this, without fasting.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p16">22. <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 30" id="i.ii.xix-p16.1" parsed="|Mark|9|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.30">Mark ix, 30</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 44" id="i.ii.xix-p16.2" parsed="|Luke|9|44|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.44">Luke ix, 44</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p17">24. When they were come to Capernaum - Where our Lord now
dwelt. This was the reason why they stayed till he came thither, to ask
him for the tribute. Doth not your Master pay tribute? - This was a
tribute or payment of a peculiar kind, being half a shekel, (that is,
about fifteen pence, ) which every master of a family used to pay yearly
to the service of the temple, to buy salt, and little things not
otherwise provided for. It seems to have been a voluntary thing, which
custom rather than any law had established.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p18">25. Jesus prevented him - Just when St. Peter was going to
ask him for it. Of their own sons, or of strangers? - That is, such as
are not of their own family.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p19">26. Then are the sons free - The sense is, This is paid for
the use of the house of God. But I am the Son of God. Therefore I am
free from any obligation of paying this to my own Father.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xix-p20">27. Yet that, we may not offend them - Even those unjust,
unreasonable men, who claim what they have no manner of right to: do not
contest it with them, but rather yield to their demand, than violate
peace or love. O what would not one of a loving spirit do for peace! Any
thing which is not expressly forbidden in the word of God. A piece of
money - The original word is a stater, which was in value two shillings
and sixpence: just the sum that was wanted. Give for me and thee - Peter
had a family of his own: the other apostles were the family of Jesus.
How illustrious a degree of knowledge and power did our Lord here
discover! Knowledge, penetrating into this animal, though beneath the
waters; and power, in directing this very fish to Peter's hook, though
he himself was at a distance! How must this have encouraged both him and
his brethren in a firm dependence on Divine Providence.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="2.48%" prev="i.ii.xix" next="i.ii.xxi" id="i.ii.xx">
<h3 id="i.ii.xx-p0.1">XVIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xviii" id="i.ii.xx-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xx-p1">1. Who is the greatest in the kingdom of heaven? - Which of
us shall be thy prime minister? They still dreamed of a temporal
kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p2">2. And Jesus calling to him a little child - This is
supposed to have been the great Ignatius, whom Trajan, the wise, the
good Emperor Trajan, condemned to be cast to the wild beasts at Rome! <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 36" id="i.ii.xx-p2.1" parsed="|Mark|9|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.36">Mark ix, 36</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 47" id="i.ii.xx-p2.2" parsed="|Luke|9|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.47">Luke ix,
47</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p3">3. Except ye be converted - The first step toward entering
into the kingdom of grace, is to become as little children: lowly in
heart, knowing yourselves utterly ignorant and helpless, and hanging
wholly on your Father who is in heaven, for a supply of all your wants.
We may further assert, (though it is doubtful whether this text implies
so much, ) except ye be turned from darkness to light, and from the
power of Satan to God:, except ye be entirely, inwardly changed, renewed
in the image of God, ye cannot enter into the kingdom of glory. Thus
must every man be converted in this life, or he can never enter into
life eternal. Ye shall in no wise enter - So far from being great in it.
<scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 14" id="i.ii.xx-p3.1" parsed="|Matt|19|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.14">Matt. xix, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p4">5, 6. And all who are in this sense little children are
unspeakably dear to me. Therefore help them all you can, as if it were
myself in person, and see that ye offend them not; that is, that ye turn
them not out of the right way, neither hinder them in it. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 40" id="i.ii.xx-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|10|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.40">Matt. x, 40</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke x. 16" id="i.ii.xx-p4.2" parsed="|Luke|10|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.16">Luke x,
16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xiii. 20" id="i.ii.xx-p4.3" parsed="|John|13|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.13.20">John xiii,
20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p5">7. Woe to the world because of offenses - That is,
unspeakable misery will be in the world through them; for it must needs
be that offenses come - Such is the nature of things, and such the
weakness, folly, and wickedness of mankind, that it cannot be but they
will come; but wo to that man - That is, miserable is that man, by whom
the offense cometh. Offenses are, all things whereby any one is turned
out of, or hindered in the way of God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p6">8, 9. If thy hand, foot, eye, cause thee to offend - If the
most dear enjoyment, the most beloved and useful person, turn thee out
of, or hinder thee in the way Is not this a hard saying? Yes; if thou
take counsel with flesh and blood. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 29" id="i.ii.xx-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|5|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.29">Matt.
v, 29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 43" id="i.ii.xx-p6.2" parsed="|Mark|9|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.43">Mark ix,
43</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p7">10. See that ye despise not one of these little ones - As
if they were beneath your notice. Be careful to receive and not to
offend, the very weakest believer in Christ: for as inconsiderable as
some of these may appear to thee, the very angels of God have a peculiar
charge over them: even those of the highest order, who continually
appear at the throne of the Most High. To behold the face of God seems
to signify the waiting near his throne; and to be an allusion to the
office of chief ministers in earthly courts, who daily converse with
their princes.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p8">11. Another, and yet a stronger reason for your not
despising them is, that I myself came into the world to save them. <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 10" id="i.ii.xx-p8.1" parsed="|Luke|19|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.10">Luke xix, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p9">12. <scripRef passage="Luke xv. 4" id="i.ii.xx-p9.1" parsed="|Luke|15|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.15.4">Luke xv,
4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p10">14. So it is not the will of your Father - Neither doth my
Father despise the least of them. Observe the gradation. The angels, the
Son, the Father.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p11">15. But how can we avoid giving offense to some? or being
offended at others! Especially suppose they are quite in the wrong?
Suppose they commit a known sin? Our Lord here teaches us how: he lays
down a sure method of avoiding all offenses. Whosoever closely observes
this threefold rule, will seldom offend others, and never be offended
himself. If any do any thing amiss, of which thou art an eye or ear
witness, thus saith the Lord, If thy brother - Any who is a member of
the same religious community: Sin against thee,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xx-p12">1. Go and reprove him alone - If it may be in
person; if that cannot so well be done, by thy messenger; or in writing.
Observe, our Lord gives no liberty to omit this; or to exchange it for
either of the following steps. If this do not succeed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xx-p13">2. Take with thee one or two more - Men whom
he esteems or loves, who may then confirm and enforce what thou sayest;
and afterward, if need require, bear witness of what was spoken. If even
this does not succeed, then, and not before,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xx-p14">3. Tell it to the elders of the Church - Lay
the whole matter open before those who watch over yours and his soul. If
all this avail not, have no farther intercourse with him, only such as
thou hast with heathens. Can any thing be plainer? Christ does here as
expressly command all Christians who see a brother do evil, to take this
way, not another, and to take these steps, in this order, as he does to
honour their father and mother. But if so, in what land do the
Christians live? If we proceed from the private carriage of man to man,
to proceedings of a more public nature, in what Christian nation are
Church censures conformed to this rule? Is this the form in which
ecclesiastical judgments appear, in the popish, or even the Protestant
world? Are these the methods used even by those who boast the most
loudly of the authority of Christ to confirm their sentences? Let us
earnestly pray, that this dishonour to the Christian name may be wiped
away, and that common humanity may not, with such solemn mockery, be
destroyed in the name of the Lord! Let him be to thee as the heathen -
To whom thou still owest earnest good will, and all the offices of
humanity. <scripRef passage="Luke xvii. 3" id="i.ii.xx-p14.1" parsed="|Luke|17|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17.3">Luke xvii, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p15">18. Whatsoever ye shall bind on earth - By excommunication,
pronounced in the spirit and power of Christ. Whatsoever ye shall loose
- By absolution from that sentence. In the primitive Church, absolution
meant no more than a discharge from Church censure. Again I say - And
not only your intercession for the penitent, but all your united
prayers, shall be heard. How great then is the power of joint prayer! If
two of you - Suppose a man and his wife. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 19" id="i.ii.xx-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|16|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.19">Matt. xvi, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p16">20. Where two or three are gathered together in my name -
That is, to worship me. I am in the midst of them - By my Spirit, to
quicken their prayers, guide their counsels, and answer their
petitions.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p17">22. Till seventy times seven - That is, as often as there
is occasion. A certain number is put for an uncertain.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p18">23. Therefore - In this respect.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p19">24. One was brought who owed him ten thousand talents -
According to the usual computation, if these were talents of gold, this
would amount to seventy-two millions sterling. If they were talents of
silver, it must have been four millions, four hundred thousand pounds.
Hereby our Lord intimates the vast number and weight of our offenses
against God, and our utter incapacity of making him any
satisfaction.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p20">25. As he had not to pay, his Lord commanded him to be sold
- Such was the power which creditors anciently had over their insolvent
debtors in several countries.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p21">30. Went with him before a magistrate, and cast him into
prison, protesting he should lie there, till he should pay the whole
debt.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xx-p22">34. His Lord delivered him to the tormentors - Imprisonment
is a much severer punishment in the eastern countries than in ours.
State criminals, especially when condemned to it, are not only confined
to a very mean and scanty allowance, but are frequently loaded with
clogs or heavy yokes, so that they can neither lie nor sit at ease: and
by frequent scourgings and sometimes rackings are brought to an untimely
end. Till he should pay all that was due to him - That is, without all
hope of release, for this he could never do. How observable is this
whole account; as well as the great inference our Lord draws from
it:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xx-p23">1. The debtor was freely and fully
forgiven;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xx-p24">2. He wilfully and grievously offended;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xx-p25">3. His pardon was retracted, the whole debt
required, and the offender delivered to the tormentors forever. And
shall we still say, but when we are once freely and fully forgiven, our
pardon can never be retracted? Verily, verily, I say unto you, So
likewise will my heavenly Father do to you, if ye from your hearts
forgive not every one his brother their trespasses.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="2.61%" prev="i.ii.xx" next="i.ii.xxii" id="i.ii.xxi">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxi-p0.1">XIX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xix" id="i.ii.xxi-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p1">1. He departed - and from that time walked no more in
Galilee. <scripRef passage="Mark x. 1" id="i.ii.xxi-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|10|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.1">Mark x, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p2">2. Multitudes followed him, and he healed them there - That
is, wheresoever they followed him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p3">3. The Pharisees came tempting him - Trying to make him
contradict Moses. For every cause - That is, for any thing which he
dislikes in her. This the scribes allowed.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p4">4. He said, Have ye not read - So instead of contradicting
him, our Lord confutes them by the very words of Moses. He who made
them, made them male and female from the beginning - At least from the
beginning of the Mosaic creation. And where do we read of any other?
Does it not follow, that God's making Eve was part of his original
design, and not a consequence of Adam's beginning to fall? By making
them one man and one woman, he condemned polygamy: by making them one
flesh, he condemned divorce.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p5">5. And said - By the mouth of Adam, who uttered the words. <scripRef passage="Gen. ii. 24" id="i.ii.xxi-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|2|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.2.24">Gen. ii, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p6">7. Why did Moses command - Christ replies, Moses permitted
(not commanded) it, because of the hardness of your hearts - Because
neither your fathers nor you could bear the more excellent way. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxiv. 1" id="i.ii.xxi-p6.1" parsed="|Deut|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.24.1">Deut. xxiv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 31" id="i.ii.xxi-p6.2" parsed="|Matt|5|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.31">Matt. v, 31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark x. 2" id="i.ii.xxi-p6.3" parsed="|Mark|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.2">Mark x, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xvi. 18" id="i.ii.xxi-p6.4" parsed="|Luke|16|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.16.18">Luke xvi, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p7">9. And I say to you - I revoke that indulgence from this
day, so that from henceforth, Whosoever, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p8">11. But he said to them - This is not universally true; it
does not hold, with regard to all men, but with regard to those only to
whom is given this excellent gift of God. Now this is given to three
sorts of persons to some by natural constitution, without their choice:
to others by violence, against their choice; and to others by grace with
their choice: who steadily withstand their natural inclinations, that
they may wait upon God without distraction.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p9">12. There are eunuchs who have made themselves eunuchs for
the kingdom of heaven's sake - Happy they! who have abstained from
marriage (though without condemning or despising it) that they might
walk more closely with God! He that is able to receive it, let him
receive it - This gracious command (for such it is unquestionably, since
to say, such a man may live single, is saying nothing. Who ever doubted
this?) is not designed for all men: but only for those few who are able
to receive it. O let these receive it joyfully!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p10">13. That he should lay his hands on them - This was a rite
which was very early used, in praying for a blessing on young persons.
See <scripRef passage="Gen. xlviii. 14, 20" id="i.ii.xxi-p10.1" parsed="|Gen|48|14|0|0;|Gen|48|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.48.14 Bible:Gen.48.20">Gen. xlviii, 14,
20</scripRef>. The disciples rebuked them - That is, them that brought
them: probably thinking such an employ beneath the dignity of their
Master. <scripRef passage="Mark x. 13" id="i.ii.xxi-p10.2" parsed="|Mark|10|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.13">Mark x, 13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xviii. 15" id="i.ii.xxi-p10.3" parsed="|Luke|18|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.18.15">Luke xviii, 15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p11">14. Of such is the kingdom of heaven - Little children,
either in a natural or spiritual sense, have a right to enter into my
kingdom. <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 3" id="i.ii.xxi-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|18|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.3">Matt. xviii,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p12">16. And behold one came - Many of the poor had followed him
from the beginning. One rich man came at last. <scripRef passage="Mark x. 17" id="i.ii.xxi-p12.1" parsed="|Mark|10|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.17">Mark x, 17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xviii. 18" id="i.ii.xxi-p12.2" parsed="|Luke|18|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.18.18">Luke xviii, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p13">17. Why callest thou me good - Whom thou supposest to be
only a man. There is none good - Supremely, originally, essentially, but
God. If thou wilt enter into life, keep the commandments - From a
principle of loving faith. Believe, and thence love and obey. And this
undoubtedly is the way to eternal life. Our Lord therefore does not
answer ironically, which had been utterly beneath his character, but
gives a plain, direct, serious answer to a serious question.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p14">19. <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 12" id="i.ii.xxi-p14.1" parsed="|Exod|20|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.12">Exod. xx,
12</scripRef>. &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p15">20. The young man saith, All these have I kept from my
childhood - So he imagined; and perhaps he had, as to the letter; but
not as to the spirit, which our Lord immediately shows.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p16">21. If thou desirest to be perfect - That is, to be a real
Christian: Sell what thou hast - He who reads the heart saw his bosom
sin was love of the world; and knew he could not be saved from this, but
by literally renouncing it. To him therefore he gave this particular
direction, which he never designed for a general rule. For him that was
necessary to salvation: to us it is not. To sell all was an absolute
duty to him; to many of us it would be an absolute sin. The young man
went away - Not being willing to have salvation at so high a price.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p17">24. It is easier for a camel to go through the eye of a
needle, (a proverbial expression, ) than for a rich man to go through
the strait gate: that is, humanly speaking, it is an absolute
impossibility. Rich man! tremble! feel this impossibility; else thou art
lost forever!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p18">25. His disciples were amazed, saying, Who then can be
saved? - If rich men, with all their advantages, cannot? Who? A poor
man; a peasant; a beggar: ten thousand of them, sooner than one that is
rich.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p19">26. Jesus looking upon them - To compose their hurried
spirits. O what a speaking look was there! Said to them - With the
utmost sweetness: With men this is impossible - It is observable, he
does not retract what he had said: no, nor soften it in the least
degree, but rather strengthens it, by representing the salvation of a
rich man as the utmost effort of Omnipotence.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p20">28. In the renovation - In the final renovation of all
things: Ye shall sit - In the beginning of the judgment they shall
stand, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. v. 10" id="i.ii.xxi-p20.1" parsed="|2Cor|5|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.5.10">2 Cor. v, 10</scripRef>. Then being absolved, they shall sit with the Judge, 1 Cor.
vi, ii, On twelve thrones - So our Lord promised, without expressing any
condition: yet as absolute as the words are, it is certain there is a
condition implied, as in many scriptures, where none is expressed. In
consequence of this, those twelve did not sit on those twelve thrones:
for the throne of Judas another took, so that he never sat thereon.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p21">29. And every one - In every age and country; not you my
apostles only; That hath forsaken houses, or brethren, or wife, or
children - Either by giving any of them up, when they could not be
retained with a clear conscience or by willingly refraining from
acquiring them: Shall receive a hundred-fold - In value, though not in
kind, even in the present world.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxi-p22">30. But many first - Many of those who were first called,
shall be last - Shall have the lowest reward: those who came after them
being preferred before them: and yet possibly both the first and the
last may be saved, though with different degrees of glory. <scripRef passage="Matt. xx. 16" id="i.ii.xxi-p22.1" parsed="|Matt|20|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.16">Matt. xx, 16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark x. 31" id="i.ii.xxi-p22.2" parsed="|Mark|10|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.31">Mark x, 31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xiii. 30" id="i.ii.xxi-p22.3" parsed="|Luke|13|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13.30">Luke xiii, 30</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="2.72%" prev="i.ii.xxi" next="i.ii.xxiii" id="i.ii.xxii">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxii-p0.1">XX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xx" id="i.ii.xxii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p1">1. That some of those who were first called may yet be
last, our Lord confirms by the following parable: of which the primary
scope is, to show, That many of the Jews would be rejected, and many of
the Gentiles accepted; the secondary, That of the Gentiles, many who
were first converted would be last and lowest in the kingdom of glory;
and many of those who were last converted would be first, and highest
therein. The kingdom of heaven is like - That is, the manner of God's
proceeding in his kingdom resembles that of a householder. In the
morning - At six, called by the Roman and Jews, the first hour. From
thence reckoning on to the evening, they called nine, the third hour;
twelve, the sixth; three in the afternoon, the ninth; and five, the
eleventh. To hire labourers into his vineyard - All who profess to be
Christians are in this sense labourers, and are supposed during their
life to be working in God's vineyard.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p2">2. The Roman penny was about seven pence halfpenny. [About
thirteen and three quarter cents, American.] This was then the usual
price of a day's labour.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p3">6. About the eleventh hour - That is, very late; long after
the rest were called.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p4">8. In the evening - Of life; or of the world.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p5">9. Who were hired about the eleventh hour - Either the
Gentiles, who were called long after the Jews into the vineyard of the
Church of Christ; or those in every age who did not hear, or at least
understand the Gospel call, till their day of life was drawing to a
period. Some circumstances of the parable seem best to suit the former,
some the latter of these senses.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p6">10. The first supposed they should have received more -
Probably the first here may mean the Jews, who supposed they should
always be preferred before the Gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p7">12. Thou hast made them equal to us - So St. Peter
expressly, <scripRef passage="Acts xv. 9" id="i.ii.xxii-p7.1" parsed="|Acts|15|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.15.9">Acts xv, 9</scripRef>. God-hath put no difference between us (Jews) and them,
(Gentiles, ) purifying their hearts by faith. And those who were equally
holy here, whenever they were called, will be equally happy
hereafter.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p8">14. It is my will to give to this last called among the
heathens even as to the first called among the Jews: yea, and to the
late converted publicans and sinners, even as to those who, were called
long before.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p9">15. Is it not lawful for me to do what I will with my own?
- Yea, doubtless, to give either to Jew or Gentile a reward infinitely
greater than he deserves. But can it be inferred from hence, that it is
lawful, or possible, for the merciful Father of spirits to "Consign an
unborn soul to hell? Or damn him from his mother's womb?" Is thine eye
evil because I am good - Art thou envious, because I am gracious? Here
is an evident reference to that malignant aspect, which is generally the
attendant of a selfish and envious temper.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p10">16. So the last shall be first, and the first last - Not
only with regard to the Jews and Gentiles, but in a thousand other
instances. For many are called - All who hear the Gospel; but few chosen
- Only those who obey it. <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 30; xxii. 14" id="i.ii.xxii-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|19|30|0|0;|Matt|22|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.30 Bible:Matt.22.14">Matt. xix, 30; xxii,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p11">17. <scripRef passage="Mark x. 32" id="i.ii.xxii-p11.1" parsed="|Mark|10|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.32">Mark x, 32</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xviii. 31" id="i.ii.xxii-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|18|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.18.31">Luke xviii, 31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p12">20. Then came to him the mother of Zebedee's children -
Considering what he had been just speaking, was ever any thing more
unreasonable? Perhaps Zebedee himself was dead, or was not a follower of
Christ. <scripRef passage="Mark x. 35" id="i.ii.xxii-p12.1" parsed="|Mark|10|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.35">Mark x, 35</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p13">21. In thy kingdom - Still they expected a temporal
kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p14">22. Ye know not what is implied in being advanced in my
kingdom, and necessarily prerequired thereto. All who share in my
kingdom must first share in my sufferings. Are you able and willing to
do this? Both these expressions, The cup, the baptism, are to be
understood of his sufferings and death. The like expressions are common
among the Jews.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p15">23. But to sit on my right hand - Christ applies to the
glories of heaven, what his disciples were so stupid as to understand of
the glories of earth. But he does not deny that this is his to give. It
is his to give in the strictest propriety, both as God, and as the Son
of man. He only asserts, that he gives it to none but those for whom it
is originally prepared; namely, those who endure to the end in the faith
that worketh by love.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p16">25. Ye know that the princes of the Gentiles Lord it over
them - And hence you imagine, the chief in my kingdom will do as they:
but it will be quite otherwise.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p17">26. Your minister - That is, your servant. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 11" id="i.ii.xxii-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|23|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.11">Matt. xxiii, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p18">29. <scripRef passage="Mark x. 46" id="i.ii.xxii-p18.1" parsed="|Mark|10|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.46">Mark x, 46</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xviii. 35" id="i.ii.xxii-p18.2" parsed="|Luke|18|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.18.35">Luke xviii, 35</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p19">30. Behold two blind men cried out - St. Mark and St. Luke
mention only one of them, blind Bartimeus. He was far the more eminent
of the two, and, as it seems, spoke for both.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxii-p20">31. The multitude charged them to hold their peace - And so
they will all who begin to cry after the Son of David. But let those who
feel their need of him cry the more; otherwise they will come short of a
cure.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="2.81%" prev="i.ii.xxii" next="i.ii.xxiv" id="i.ii.xxiii">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxiii-p0.1">XXI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xxi" id="i.ii.xxiii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Mark xi. 1" id="i.ii.xxiii-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|11|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11.1">Mark xi, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 29" id="i.ii.xxiii-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|19|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.29">Luke xix, 29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xii. 12" id="i.ii.xxiii-p1.3" parsed="|John|12|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.12">John xii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p2">5. The daughter of Sion - That is, the inhabitants of
Jerusalem: the first words of the passage are cited from <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxii. 11" id="i.ii.xxiii-p2.1" parsed="|Isa|62|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.62.11">Isaiah lxii, 11</scripRef>; the rest from <scripRef passage="Zech. ix. 9" id="i.ii.xxiii-p2.2" parsed="|Zech|9|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.9.9">Zech. ix, 9</scripRef>. The ancient Jewish doctors were wont to apply these
prophecies to the Messiah. On an ass - The Prince of Peace did not take
a horse, a warlike animal. But he will ride on that by and by, <scripRef passage="Rev. xix. 11" id="i.ii.xxiii-p2.3" parsed="|Rev|19|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.19.11">Rev. xix,
11</scripRef>. In the patriarchal ages, illustrious persons thought it no
disgrace to make use of this animal: but it by no means appears, that
this opinion prevailed, or this custom continued, till the reign of
Tiberias. Was it a mean attitude wherein our Lord then appeared? Mean
even to contempt! I grant it: I glory in it: it is for the comfort of my
soul for the honour of his humility, and for the utter confusion of all
worldly pomp and grandeur.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p3">7. They set him thereon - That is, on the clothes.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p4">8. A great multitude spread their garments in the way - A
custom which was usual at the creation of a king, <scripRef passage="2 Kings ix. 13" id="i.ii.xxiii-p4.1" parsed="|2Kgs|9|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.9.13">2 Kings ix, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p5">9. The multitudes cried, saying - Probably from a Divine
impulse; for certainly most of them understood not the words they
uttered. Hoseanna - (Lord save us) was a solemn word in frequent use
among the Jews. The meaning is, "We sing hosanna to the Son of David.
Blessed is he, the Messiah, of the Lord. Save. Thou that art in the
highest heavens." Our Lord restrained all public tokens of honour from
the people till now, lest the envy of his enemies should interrupt his
preaching before the time. But this reason now ceasing, he suffered
their acclamations, that they might be a public testimony against their
wickedness, who in four or five days after cried out, Crucify him,
crucify him. The expressions recorded by the other evangelists are
somewhat different from these: but all of them were undoubtedly used by
some or others of the multitude.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p6">11. This is Jesus from Nazareth - What a stumbling block
was this! if he was of Nazareth, he could not be the Messiah. But they
who earnestly desired to know the truth would not stumble thereat: for
upon inquiry (which such would not fail to make) they would find, he was
not of Nazareth, but Bethlehem.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p7">12. He cast out all that sold and bought - Doves and oxen
for sacrifice. He had cast them out three years before, <scripRef passage="John ii. 14" id="i.ii.xxiii-p7.1" parsed="|John|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.2.14">John ii, 14</scripRef>; bidding them not make that house a house of merchandise.
Upon the repetition of the offense, he used sharper words. In the temple
- That is, in the outer court of it, where the Gentiles used to worship.
The money changers - The exchangers of foreign money into current coin,
which those who came from distant parts might want to offer for the
service of the temple. <scripRef passage="Mark xi. 11, 15" id="i.ii.xxiii-p7.2" parsed="|Mark|11|11|0|0;|Mark|11|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11.11 Bible:Mark.11.15">Mark xi, 11, 15</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 45" id="i.ii.xxiii-p7.3" parsed="|Luke|19|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.45">Luke xix, 45</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p8">13. A den of thieves - A proverbial expression, for a
harbour of wicked men. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lvi. 7" id="i.ii.xxiii-p8.1" parsed="|Isa|56|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.56.7">Isaiah lvi,
7</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Jer. vii. 11" id="i.ii.xxiii-p8.2" parsed="|Jer|7|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.7.11">Jer. vii,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p9">16. <scripRef passage="Psalm viii. 2" id="i.ii.xxiii-p9.1" parsed="|Ps|8|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.8.2">Psalm viii,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p10">17. <scripRef passage="Mark xi. 11, 12" id="i.ii.xxiii-p10.1" parsed="|Mark|11|11|11|12" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11.11-Mark.11.12">Mark xi, 11,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p11">20. The disciples seeing it - As they went by, the next
day.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p12">21. Jesus answering, said, If ye have faith - Whence we may
learn, that one great end of our Lord in this miracle was to confirm and
increase their faith: another was, to warn them against unfruitfulness. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 20" id="i.ii.xxiii-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|17|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.20">Matt. xvii, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p13">23. When he was come into the temple, the chief priests
came - Who thought he violated their right: and the elders of the people
- Probably, members of the sanhedrim, to whom that title most properly
belonged: which is the more probable, as they were the persons under
whose cognizance the late action of Christ, in purging the temple, would
naturally fall. These, with the chief priests, seem purposely to have
appeared in a considerable company, to give the more weight to what they
said, and if need were, to bear a united testimony against him. As he
was teaching - Which also they supposed he had no authority to do, being
neither priest, nor Levite, nor scribe. Some of the priests (though not
as priests) and all the scribes were authorized teachers. By what
authority dost thou these things - Publicly teach the people! And drive
out those who had our commission to traffic in the outer court? <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 1" id="i.ii.xxiii-p13.1" parsed="|Luke|20|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.1">Luke xx, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xi. 27" id="i.ii.xxiii-p13.2" parsed="|Mark|11|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11.27">Mark xi, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p14">24. I will ask you one thing - Who have asked me many: The
baptism, that is, the whole ministry of John, was it from heaven or from
men? - By what authority did he act and teach? Did man or God give him
that authority? Was it not God? But if so, the consequence was clear.
For John testified that Jesus was the Christ.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p15">25. Why did ye not believe him - Testifying this.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p16">27. Neither tell I you - Not again, in express terms: he
had often told them before, and they would not believe him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p17">30. He answered, I go, sir: but went not - Just so did the
scribes and Pharisees: they professed the greatest readiness and zeal in
the service of God: but it was bare profession, contradicted by all
their actions.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p18">32. John came in a way of righteousness - Walking in it, as
well as teaching it. The publicans and harlots - The most notorious
sinners were reformed, though at first they said, I will not. And ye
seeing the amazing change which was wrought in them, though at first ye
said, I go, sir, repented not afterward - Were no more convinced than
before. O how is this scripture fulfilled at this day!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p19">33. A certain householder planted a vineyard - God planted
the Church in Canaan; and hedged it round about - First with the law,
then with his peculiar providence: and digged a wine press - Perhaps it
may mean Jerusalem: and built a tower - The temple: and went into a far
country - That is, left the keepers of his vineyard, in some measure, to
behave as they should see good. <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 1" id="i.ii.xxiii-p19.1" parsed="|Mark|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.1">Mark
xii, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 9" id="i.ii.xxiii-p19.2" parsed="|Luke|20|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.9">Luke xx,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p20">34. He sent his servants - His extraordinary messengers,
the prophets: to the husbandmen - The ordinary preachers or ministers of
the Jews.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p21">41. They say - Perhaps some of the by-standers, not the
chief priests or Pharisees; who, as St. Luke relates, said, God forbid, <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 16" id="i.ii.xxiii-p21.1" parsed="|Luke|20|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.16">Luke xx, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p22">42. The builders - The scribes and priests, whose office it
was to build up the Church. Is become the head of the corner - Or the
chief corner stone: he is become the foundation of the Church, on which
the whole building rests, and is the principal corner stone, for uniting
the Gentiles to it, as the chief corner stone of a house supports and
links its two sides together. <scripRef passage="Psalm cxviii. 22" id="i.ii.xxiii-p22.1" parsed="|Ps|118|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.118.22">Psalm
cxviii, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p23">43. Therefore - Because ye reject this corner stone. The
kingdom of God - That is, the Gospel.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiii-p24">44. Whosoever shall fall on this stone shall be broken -
Stumblers at Christ shall even then receive much hurt. He is said to
fall on this stone, who hears the Gospel and does not believe. But on
whomsoever it shall fall - In vengeance, it will utterly destroy him. It
will fall on every unbeliever, when Christ cometh in the clouds of
heaven. <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 18" id="i.ii.xxiii-p24.1" parsed="|Luke|20|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.18">Luke xx, 18</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="2.92%" prev="i.ii.xxiii" next="i.ii.xxv" id="i.ii.xxiv">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxiv-p0.1">XXII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xxii" id="i.ii.xxiv-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.22" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p1">1. Jesus answering, spake - That is, spake with reference
to what had just past.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p2">2. A king, who made a marriage feast for his son - So did
God, when he brought his first - begotten into the world.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p3">3. Them that were invited - Namely, the Jews.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p4">4. Fatlings - Fatted beasts and fowls.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p5">5. One to his farm, another to his merchandise - One must
mind what he has; another, gain what he wants. How many perish by
misusing lawful things!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p6">7. The king sending forth his troops - The Roman armies
employed of God for that purpose. Destroyed those murderers - Primarily
the Jews.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p7">8. Go into the highways - The word properly signifies, the
by- ways, or turnings of the road.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p8">10. They gathered all - By preaching everwhere.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p9">11. The guest - The members of the visible Church.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p10">12. A wedding garment - The righteousness of Christ, first
imputed, then implanted. It may easily be observed, this has no relation
to the Lord's Supper, but to God's proceeding at the last day.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p11">14. Many are called; few chosen - Many hear; few believe.
Yea, many are members of the visible, but few of the invisible Church. <scripRef passage="Matt. xx. 16" id="i.ii.xxiv-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|20|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.16">Matt. xx, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p12">15. <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 13" id="i.ii.xxiv-p12.1" parsed="|Mark|12|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.13">Mark xii,
13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 20" id="i.ii.xxiv-p12.2" parsed="|Luke|20|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.20">Luke xx,
20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p13">16. The Herodians were a set of men peculiarly attached to
Herod, and consequently zealous for the interest of the Roman
government, which was the main support of the dignity and royalty of his
family. Thou regardest not the person of men - Thou favourest no man for
his riches or greatness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p14">17. Is it lawful to give tribute to Caesar? - If he had
said, Yes, the Pharisees would have accused him to the people, as a
betrayer of the liberties of his country. If he had said, No, the
Herodians would have accused him to the Roman governor.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p15">18. Ye hypocrites - Pretending a scruple of conscience.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p16">20. The tribute money - A Roman coin, stamped with the head
of Caesar, which was usually paid in tribute.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p17">21. They say to him, Caesar's - Plainly acknowledging, by
their having received his coin, that they were under his government. And
indeed this is a standing rule. The current coin of every nation shows
who is the supreme governor of it. Render therefore, ye Pharisees, to
Caesar the things which ye yourselves acknowledge to be Ciaesar's: and, ye
Herodians, while ye are zealous for Caesar, see that ye render to God the
things that are God's.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p18">23. <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 18" id="i.ii.xxiv-p18.1" parsed="|Mark|12|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.18">Mark xii,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p19">24. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 5" id="i.ii.xxiv-p19.1" parsed="|Deut|25|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.5">Deut. xxv,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p20">25. Now there were with us seven brethren -- this story
seems to have been a kind of common-place objection, which no doubt they
brought upon all occasions.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p21">29. Ye err, not knowing the Scriptures - Which plainly
assert a resurrection. Nor the power of God - Which is well able to
effect it. How many errors flow from the same source?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p22">30. They are as the angels - Incorruptible and immortal. So
is the power of God shown in them! So little need had they of
marriage!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p23">31. Have ye not read - The Sadducees had a peculiar value
for the books of Moses. Out of these therefore our Lord argues with
them.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p24">32. I am the God of Abraham - The argument runs thus: God
is not the God of the dead, but of the living: (for that expression, Thy
God, implies both benefit from God to man, and duty from man to God) but
he is the God of Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob: therefore, Abraham, Isaac,
and Jacob are not dead, but living. Therefore, the soul does not die
with the body. So indeed the Sadducees supposed, and it was on this
ground that they denied the resurrection. <scripRef passage="Exod. iii. 6" id="i.ii.xxiv-p24.1" parsed="|Exod|3|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3.6">Exod. iii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p25">33. At his doctrine - At the clearness and solidity of his
answers.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p26">34. <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 28" id="i.ii.xxiv-p26.1" parsed="|Mark|12|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.28">Mark xii,
28</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke x. 25" id="i.ii.xxiv-p26.2" parsed="|Luke|10|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.25">Luke x, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p27">35. A scribe asking him a question, trying him - Not, as it
seems, with any ill design: but barely to make a further trial of that
wisdom, which he had shown in silencing the Sadducees.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p28">37. <scripRef passage="Deut. vi. 5" id="i.ii.xxiv-p28.1" parsed="|Deut|6|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.6.5">Deut. vi,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p29">39. <scripRef passage="Lev. xix. 18" id="i.ii.xxiv-p29.1" parsed="|Lev|19|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.18">Lev. xix,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p30">42. <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 41" id="i.ii.xxiv-p30.1" parsed="|Luke|20|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.41">Luke xx,
41</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p31">43. How doth David then by the Spirit - By inspiration,
call him Lord? If he be merely the son (or descendant) of David? If he
be, as you suppose, a mere man, the son of a man?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p32">44. The Lord said to my Lord - This his dominion, to which
David himself was subject, shows both the heavenly majesty of the king,
and the nature of his kingdom. Sit thou on my right hand - That is,
remain in the highest authority and power. <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 1" id="i.ii.xxiv-p32.1" parsed="|Ps|110|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.1">Psalm cx, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxiv-p33">46. Neither durst any question him any more - Not by way of
ensnaring or tempting him.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="3.00%" prev="i.ii.xxiv" next="i.ii.xxvi" id="i.ii.xxv">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxv-p0.1">XXIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xxiii" id="i.ii.xxv-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p1">1. Then - Leaving all converse with his adversaries, whom
he now left to the hardness of their hearts.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p2">2. The scribes sit in the chair of Moses - That is, read
and expound the law of Moses, and are their appointed teachers.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p3">3. All things therefore - Which they read out of the law,
and enforce therefrom.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p4">4. <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 46" id="i.ii.xxv-p4.1" parsed="|Luke|11|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.46">Luke xi,
46</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p5">5. Their phylacteries - The Jews, understanding those words
literally, It shall be as a token upon thy hand, and as frontlets
between thine eyes, <scripRef passage="Exod. xiii. 16" id="i.ii.xxv-p5.1" parsed="|Exod|13|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.13.16">Exod. xiii,
16</scripRef>. And thou shalt bind these words for a sign upon thine hand,
and they shall be as frontlets between thine eyes, <scripRef passage="Deut. vi. 8" id="i.ii.xxv-p5.2" parsed="|Deut|6|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.6.8">Deut. vi, 8</scripRef>; used to wear little scrolls of paper or parchment, bound on
their wrist and foreheads, on which several texts of Scripture were
writ. These they supposed, as a kind of charm, would preserve them from
danger. And hence they seem to have been called phylacteries, or
preservatives. The fringes of their garments - Which God had enjoined
them to wear, to remind them of doing all the commandments, <scripRef passage="Num. xv. 38" id="i.ii.xxv-p5.3" parsed="|Num|15|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.15.38">Num. xv, 38</scripRef>. These, as well as their phylacteries, the Pharisees
affected to wear broader and larger than other men. <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 38" id="i.ii.xxv-p5.4" parsed="|Mark|12|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.38">Mark xii,
38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p6">8, 9, 10. The Jewish rabbis were also called father and
master, by their several disciples, whom they required,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxv-p7">1. To believe implicitly what they affirmed,
without asking any further reason;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxv-p8">2. To obey implicitly what they enjoined,
without seeking further authority. Our Lord, therefore, by forbidding us
either to give or receive the title of rabbi, master, or father, forbids
us either to receive any such reverence, or to pay any such to any but
God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p9">11. <scripRef passage="Matt. xx. 26" id="i.ii.xxv-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|20|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.26">Matt. xx,
26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p10">12. Whosoever shall exalt himself shall be humbled, and he
that shall humble himself shall be exalted - It is observable that no
one sentence of our Lord's is so often repeated as this: it occurs, with
scarce any variation, at least ten times in the evangelists. <scripRef passage="Luke xiv. 11; xviii. 14" id="i.ii.xxv-p10.1" parsed="|Luke|14|11|0|0;|Luke|18|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.14.11 Bible:Luke.18.14">Luke xiv, 11; xviii, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p11">13. Woe to you - Our Lord pronounced eight blessings upon
the mount: he pronounces eight woes here; not as imprecations, but
solemn, compassionate declarations of the misery, which these stubborn
sinners were bringing upon themselves. Ye go not in - For ye are not
poor in spirit; and ye hinder those that would be so.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p12">14. <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 40" id="i.ii.xxv-p12.1" parsed="|Mark|12|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.40">Mark xii,
40</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 47" id="i.ii.xxv-p12.2" parsed="|Luke|20|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.47">Luke xx,
47</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p13">16. Woe to you, ye blind guides - Before he had styled them
hypocrites, from their personal character: now he gives them another
title, respecting their influence upon others. Both these appellations
are severely put together in the 23rd and 25th verses; and this severity
rises to the height in the 33rd verse. The gold of the temple - The
treasure kept there. He is bound - To keep his oath.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p14">20. He that sweareth by the altar, sweareth by it, and by
all things thereon - Not only by the gift, but by the holy fire, and the
sacrifice; and above all, by that God to whom they belong; inasmuch as
every oath by a creature is an implicit appeal to God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p15">23. Judgment - That is, justice: Faith - The word here
means fidelity.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p16">24. Ye blind guides, who teach others to do as you do
yourselves, to strain out a gnat - From the liquor they are going to
drink! and swallow a camel - It is strange, that glaring false print,
strain at a gnat, which quite alters the sense, should run through all
the editions of our English Bibles.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p17">25. Full of rapine and intemperance - The censure is double
(taking intemperance in the vulgar sense.) These miserable men procured
unjustly what they used intemperately. No wonder tables so furnished
prove a snare, as many find by sad experience. Thus luxury punishes
fraud while it feeds disease with the fruits of injustice. But
intemperance in the full sense takes in not only all kinds of outward
intemperance, particularly in eating and drinking, but all intemperate
or immoderate desires, whether of honour, gain, or sensual pleasure.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p18">26. Ye build the tombs of the prophets - And that is all,
for ye neither observe their sayings, nor imitate their actions.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p19">30. We would not have been partakers - So ye make fair
professions, as did your fathers.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p20">31. Wherefore ye testify against yourselves - By your
smooth words as well as devilish actions: that ye are the genuine sons
of them who killed the prophets of their own times, while they professed
the utmost veneration for those of past ages. From the 3rd to the 30th
is exposed every thing that commonly passes in the world for religion,
whereby the pretenders to it keep both themselves and others from
entering into the kingdom of God; from attaining, or even seeking after
those tempers, in which alone true Christianity consists. As,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxv-p21">1. Punctuality in attending on public and
private prayer, ver. 4-14. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 4-14" id="i.ii.xxv-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|23|4|23|14" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.4-Matt.23.14">Matt.
xxiii, 4-14</scripRef></p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxv-p22">2. Zeal to make proselytes to our opinion or
communion, though they have less of the spirit of religion than before,
ver. 15.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxv-p23">3. A superstitious reverence for consecrated
places or things, without any for Him to whom they are consecrated, ver.
16-22.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxv-p24">4. A scrupulous exactness in little
observances, though with the neglect of justice, mercy, and faith, ver.
23, 24.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxv-p25">5. A nice cautiousness to cleanse the outward
behaviour, but without any regard to inward purity, ver. 25, 26.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxv-p26">6. A specious face of virtue and piety,
covering the deepest hypocrisy and villany, ver. 27, 28.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxv-p27">7. A professed veneration for all good men,
except those among whom they live.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p28">32. Fill ye up - A word of permission, not of command: as
if he had said, I contend with you no longer: I leave you to yourselves:
you have conquered: now ye may follow the devices of your own hearts.
The measure of your fathers - Wickedness: ye may now be as wicked as
they.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p29">33. Ye serpents - Our Lord having now lost all hope of
reclaiming these, speaks so as to affright others from the like
sins.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p30">34. Wherefore - That it may appear you are the true
children of those murderers, and have a right to have their iniquities
visited on you: Behold, I send - Is not this speaking as one having
authority? Prophets - Men with supernatural credentials: Wise men - Such
as have both natural abilities and experience; and scribes - Men of
learning: but all will not avail. <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 49" id="i.ii.xxv-p30.1" parsed="|Luke|11|49|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.49">Luke
xi, 49</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p31">35. That upon you may come - The consequence of which will
be, that upon you will come the vengeance of all the righteous blood
shed on the earth - Zechariah the son of Barachiah - Termed Jehoiada, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxiv. 20" id="i.ii.xxv-p31.1" parsed="|2Chr|24|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.24.20">2 Chron. xxiv, 20</scripRef>, where the story is related: Ye slew - Ye make that murder
also of your fathers your own, by imitating it: Between the temple -
That is, the inner temple, and the altar - Which stood in the outer
court. Our Lord seems to refer to this instance, rather than any other,
because he was the last of the prophets on record that were slain by the
Jews for reproving their wickedness: and because God's requiring this
blood as well as that of Abel, is particularly taken notice of in
Scripture.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p32">37. <scripRef passage="Luke xiii. 34" id="i.ii.xxv-p32.1" parsed="|Luke|13|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13.34">Luke xiii,
34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p33">38. Behold your house - The temple, which is now your
house, not God's: Is left unto you - Our Lord spake this as he was going
out of it for the last time: Desolate - Forsaken of God and his Christ,
and sentenced to utter destruction.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxv-p34">39. Ye - Jews in general; men of Jerusalem in particular:
shall not see me from this time - Which includes the short space till
his death, till, after a long interval of desolation and misery, ye say,
Blessed is he that cometh in the name of the Lord - Ye receive me with
joyful and thankful hearts. This also shall be accomplished in its
season.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="3.13%" prev="i.ii.xxv" next="i.ii.xxvii" id="i.ii.xxvi">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxvi-p0.1">XXIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xxiv" id="i.ii.xxvi-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 1" id="i.ii.xxvi-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|13|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.1">Mark xiii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 5" id="i.ii.xxvi-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|21|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.5">Luke xxi,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p2">2. There shall not be left one stone upon another - This
was most punctually fulfilled; for after the temple was burnt, Titus,
the Roman general, ordered the very foundations of it to be dug up;
after which the ground on which it stood was ploughed up by Turnus
Rufus.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p3">3. As he sat on the Mount of Olives - Whence they had a
full view of the temple. When shall these things be? And what shall be
the sign of thy coming, and of the end of the world? - The disciples
inquire confusedly</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxvi-p4">1. Concerning the time of the destruction of
the temple;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxvi-p5">2. Concerning the signs of Christ's coming,
and of the end of the world, as if they imagined these two were the same
thing. Our Lord answers distinctly concerning</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.xxvi-p6">1. The destruction of the temple and city,
with the signs preceding, ver. 4, &amp;c., 15, &amp;c.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.xxvi-p7">2. His own coming, and the end of the world,
with the signs thereof, ver. 29-31.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.xxvi-p8">3. The time of the destruction of the temple,
ver. 32, &amp;c.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.ii.xxvi-p9">4. The time of the end of the world, ver.
36.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p10">4. Take heed that no man deceive you - The caution is more
particularly designed for the succeeding Christians, whom the apostles
then represented. The first sign of my coming is, the rise of false
prophets. But it is highly probable, many of these things refer to more
important events, which are yet to come.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p11">5. Many shall come in my name - First, false Christs, next,
false prophets, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 11" id="i.ii.xxvi-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|24|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.11">Matt. xxiv,
11</scripRef>. At length, both together, ver. 24. And indeed never did so
many impostors appear in the world as a few years before the destruction
of Jerusalem; undoubtedly because that was the time wherein the Jews in
general expected the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p12">6. Wars - Near: Rumours of wars - At a distance. All these
things must come to pass - As a foundation for lasting tranquillity. But
the end - Concerning which ye inquire, is not yet - So far from it, that
this is but the beginning sorrows.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p13">9. Then shall they deliver you up to affliction - As if ye
were the cause of all these evils. And ye shall be hated of all nations
- Even of those who tolerate all other sects and parties; but in no
nation will the children of the devil tolerate the children of God. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 17" id="i.ii.xxvi-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|10|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.17">Matt. x, 17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p14">10. Then shall many be offended - So as utterly to make
shipwreck of faith and a pure conscience. But hold ye fast faith, ver.
11. in spite of false prophets: love, even when iniquity and offenses
abound, ver. 12. And hope, unto the end, ver. 13. He that does so, shall
be snatched out of the burning. The love of many will wax cold - The
generality of those who love God will (like the Church at Ephesus, <scripRef passage="Rev. ii. 4" id="i.ii.xxvi-p14.1" parsed="|Rev|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.2.4">Rev. ii, 4</scripRef>, ) leave their first love.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p15">13. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 22" id="i.ii.xxvi-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|10|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.22">Matt. x, 22</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 13" id="i.ii.xxvi-p15.2" parsed="|Mark|13|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.13">Mark xiii, 13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 17" id="i.ii.xxvi-p15.3" parsed="|Luke|21|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.17">Luke xxi, 17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p16">14. This Gospel shall be preached in all the world - Not
universally: this is not done yet: but in general through the several
parts of the world, and not only in Judea And this was done by St. Paul
and the other apostles, before Jerusalem was destroyed. And then shall
the end come - Of the city and temple. Josephus's History of the Jewish
War is the best commentary on this chapter. it is a wonderful instance
of God's providence, that he, an eye witness, and one who lived and died
a Jew, should, especially in so extraordinary a manner, be preserved, to
transmit to us a collection of important facts, which so exactly
illustrate this glorious prophecy, in almost every circumstance. <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 10" id="i.ii.xxvi-p16.1" parsed="|Mark|13|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.10">Mark xiii, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p17">15. When ye see the abomination of desolation - Daniel's
term is, The abomination that maketh desolate, <scripRef passage="Dan. xi. 31" id="i.ii.xxvi-p17.1" parsed="|Dan|11|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.11.31">Dan. xi, 31</scripRef>; that is, the standards of the desolating legions, on which
they bear the abominable images of their idols: Standing in the holy
place - Not only the temple and the mountain on which it stood, but the
whole city of Jerusalem, and several furlongs of land round about it,
were accounted holy; particularly the mount on which our Lord now sat,
and on which the Roman afterward planted their ensigns. He that readeth
let him understand - Whoever reads that prophecy of Daniel, let him
deeply consider it. <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 14" id="i.ii.xxvi-p17.2" parsed="|Mark|13|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.14">Mark xiii, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 20" id="i.ii.xxvi-p17.3" parsed="|Luke|21|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.20">Luke xxi, 20</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Dan. ix. 27" id="i.ii.xxvi-p17.4" parsed="|Dan|9|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.9.27">Dan. ix, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p18">16. Then let them who are in Judea flee to the mountains -
So the Christians did, and were preserved. It is remarkable that after
the Roman under Cestus Gallus made their first advances toward
Jerusalem, they suddenly withdrew again, in a most unexpected and indeed
impolitic manner. This the Christians took as a signal to retire, which
they did, some to Pella, and others to Mount Libanus.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p19">17. Let not him that is on the house top come down to take
any thing out of his house - It may be remembered that their stairs used
to be on the outside of their houses.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p20">19. Woe to them that are with child, and to them that give
suck - Because they cannot so readily make their escape.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p21">20. Pray ye that your flight be not in the winter - They
did so; and their flight was in the spring. Neither on the Sabbath -
Being on many accounts inconvenient; beside that many would have
scrupled to travel far on that day. For the Jews thought it unlawful to
walk above two thousand paces (two miles) on the Sabbath day.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p22">21. Then shall be great tribulation - Have not many things
spoken in the chapter, as well as in Mark xiii, , Luke xxi, . a farther
and much more extensive meaning than has been yet fulfilled?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p23">22. And unless those days were shortened - By the taking of
Jerusalem sooner than could be expected: No flesh would be saved - The
whole nation would be destroyed. But for the elect's sake - That is, for
the sake of the Christians.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p24">23. <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 21" id="i.ii.xxvi-p24.1" parsed="|Mark|13|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.21">Mark xiii,
21</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xvii. 23" id="i.ii.xxvi-p24.2" parsed="|Luke|17|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17.23">Luke xvii,
23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p25">24. They would deceive, if possible, the very elect - But
it is not possible that God should suffer the body of Christians to be
thus deceived.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p26">27. For as the lightning goeth forth - For the next coming
of Christ will be as quick as lightning; so that there will not be time
for any such previous warning.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p27">28. For wheresoever the carcass is, there will the eagles
he gathered together - Our Lord gives this, as a farther reason, why
they should not hearken to any pretended deliverer. As if he had said,
Expect not any deliverer of the Jewish nation; for it is devoted to
destruction. It is already before God a dead carcass, which the Roman
eagles will soon devour. <scripRef passage="Luke xvii. 37" id="i.ii.xxvi-p27.1" parsed="|Luke|17|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17.37">Luke xvii,
37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p28">29. Immediately after the tribulation of those days - Here
our Lord begins to speak of his last coming. But he speaks not so much
in the language of man as of God, with whom a thousand years are as one
day, one moment. Many of the primitive Christians not observing this,
thought he would come immediately, in the common sense of the word: a
mistake which St. Paul labours to remove, in his Second Epistle to the
Thessalonians. The powers of the heavens - Probably the influences of
the heavenly bodies. <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 24" id="i.ii.xxvi-p28.1" parsed="|Mark|13|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.24">Mark xiii,
24</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 25" id="i.ii.xxvi-p28.2" parsed="|Luke|21|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.25">Luke xxi,
25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p29">30. Then shall appear the sign of the Son of man in heaven
- It seems a little before he himself descends. The sun, moon, and stars
being extinguished, (probably not those of our system only) the sign
of the Son of man (perhaps the cross) will appear in the glory of the
Lord.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p30">31. They shall gather together his elect - That is, all
that have endured to the end in the faith which worketh by love.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p31">32. Learn a parable - Our Lord having spoke of the signs
preceding the two grand events, concerning which the apostles had
inquired, begins here to speak of the time of them. And to the question
proposed, ver. 3, concerning the time of the destruction of Jerusalem,
he answers ver. 34. Concerning the time of the end of the world, he
answers chap. xxiv, 36. <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 28" id="i.ii.xxvi-p31.1" parsed="|Mark|13|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.28">Mark xiii,
28</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 29" id="i.ii.xxvi-p31.2" parsed="|Luke|21|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.29">Luke xxi, 29</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p32">34. This generation of men now living shall not pass till
all these things be done - The expression implies, that great part of
that generation would be passed away, but not the whole. Just so it was.
For the city and temple were destroyed thirty-nine or forty years
after.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p33">36. But of that day - The day of judgment; Knoweth no man -
Not while our Lord was on earth. Yet it might be afterward revealed to
St. John consistently with this.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p34">37. <scripRef passage="Luke xvii. 26" id="i.ii.xxvi-p34.1" parsed="|Luke|17|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17.26">Luke xvii,
26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p35">40. One is taken - Into God's immediate protection: and one
is left - To share the common calamities. Our Lord speaks as having the
whole transaction present before his eyes.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p36">41. Two women shall be grinding - Which was then a common
employment of women.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p37">42. Ye know not what hour your Lord cometh - Either to
require your soul of you, or to avenge himself of this nation. <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 33" id="i.ii.xxvi-p37.1" parsed="|Mark|13|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.33">Mark xiii, 33</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 35; xxi. 34" id="i.ii.xxvi-p37.2" parsed="|Luke|12|35|0|0;|Luke|21|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.35 Bible:Luke.21.34">Luke xii, 35; xxi, 34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p38">45. Who then is the faithful and wise servant - Which of
you aspires after this character? Wise - Every moment retaining the
clearest conviction, that all he now has is only intrusted to him as a
steward: Faithful - Thinking, speaking, and acting continually, in a
manner suitable to that conviction.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p39">48. But if that evil servant - Now evil, having put away
faith and a good conscience.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvi-p40">51. And allot him his portion with the hypocrites - The
worst of sinners, as upright and sincere as he was once. If ministers
are the persons here primarily intended, there is a peculiar propriety
in the expression. For no hypocrisy can be baser, than to call ourselves
ministers of Christ, while we are the slaves of avarice, ambition, or
sensuality. Wherever such are found, may God reform them by his grace,
or disarm them of that power and influence, which they continually abuse
to his dishonour, and to their own aggravated damnation!</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="3.30%" prev="i.ii.xxvi" next="i.ii.xxviii" id="i.ii.xxvii">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxvii-p0.1">XXV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xxv" id="i.ii.xxvii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.25" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p1">This chapter contains the last public discourse which our
Lord uttered before he was offered up. He had before frequently declared
what would be the portion of all the workers of iniquity. But what will
become of those who do no harm? Honest, inoffensive, good sort of
people? We have here a clear and full answer to this important
question.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p2">1. Then shall the kingdom of heaven - That is, the
candidates for it, be like ten virgins - The bridemaids on the wedding
night were wont to go to the house where the bride was, with burning
lamps or torches in their hands, to wait for the bride groom's coming.
When he drew near, they went to meet him with their lamps, and to
conduct him to the bride.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p3">3. The foolish took no oil with them - No more than kept
them burning just for the present. None to supply their future want, to
recruit their lamp's decay. The lamp is faith. A lamp and oil with it,
is faith working by love.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p4">4. The wise took oil in their vessels - Love in their
hearts. And they daily sought a fresh supply of spiritual strength, till
their faith was made perfect.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p5">5. While the bridegroom delayed - That is, before they were
called to attend him, they all slumbered and slept - Were easy and
quiet, the wise enjoying a true, the foolish a false peace.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p6">6. At midnight - In an hour quite unthought of.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p7">7. They trimmed their lamps - They examined themselves and
prepared to meet their God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p8">8. Give us of your oil, for our lamps are gone out - Our
faith is dead. What a time to discover this! Whether it mean the time of
death, or of judgment. Unto which of the saints wilt thou then turn? Who
can help thee at such a season?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p9">9. But the wise answered, Lest there be not enough for us
and you! - Beginning the sentence with a beautiful abruptness; such as
showed their surprise at the state of those poor wretches, who had so
long received them, as well as their own souls. Lest there be not enough
- It is sure there is not; for no man has more than holiness enough for
himself. Go ye rather to them that sell - Without money and without
price: that is, to God, to Christ. And buy - If ye can. O no! The time
is past and returns no more!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p10">13. Watch therefore - He that watches has not only a
burning lamp, but likewise oil in his vessel. And even when he sleepeth,
his heart waketh. He is quiet; but not secure.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p11">14. Our Lord proceeds by a parable still plainer (if that
can be) to declare the final reward of a harmless man. May God give all
such in this their day, ears to hear and hearts to understand it! The
kingdom of heaven - That is, the King of heaven, Christ. <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 34" id="i.ii.xxvii-p11.1" parsed="|Mark|13|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.34">Mark xiii, 34</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 12" id="i.ii.xxvii-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|19|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.12">Luke xix, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p12">15. To one he gave five talents, to another two, and to
another one - And who knows whether (all circumstances considered) there
be a greater disproportion than this, in the talents of those who have
received the most, and those who have received the fewest? According to
his own ability - The words may be translated more literally, according
to his own mighty power. And immediately took his journey - To
heaven.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p13">18. He that had received one - Made his having fewer
talents than others a pretense for not improving any. Went and hid his
master's money - Reader, art thou doing the same? Art thou hiding the
talent God hath lent thee?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p14">24. I knew thou art a hard man - No. Thou knowest him not.
He never knew God, who thinks him a hard master. Reaping where thou hast
not sown - That is, requiring more of us than thou hast given us power
to perform. So does every obstinate sinner, in one kind or other, lay
the blame of his own sins on God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p15">25. And I was afraid - Lest if I had improved my talent, I
should have had the more to answer for. So from this fear, one will not
learn to read, another will not hear sermons!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p16">26. Thou knewest - That I require impossibilities! This is
not an allowing, but a strong denial of the charge.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p17">27. Thou oughtest therefore - On that very account, on thy
own supposition, to have improved my talent, as far as was possible.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p18">29. To every one that hath shall be given - So close does
God keep to this stated rule, from the beginning to the end of the
world. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 12" id="i.ii.xxvii-p18.1" parsed="|Matt|13|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.12">Matt. xiii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p19">30. Cast ye the unprofitable servant into the outer
darkness - For what? what had he done? It is true he had not done good.
But neither is he charged with doing any harm. Why, for this reason, for
barely doing no harm, he is consigned to outer darkness. He is
pronounced a wicked, because he was a slothful, an unprofitable servant.
So mere harmlessness, on which many build their hope of salvation, was
the cause of his damnation! There shall be the weeping - Of the careless
thoughtless sinner; and the gnashing of teeth - Of the proud and
stubborn. The same great truth, that there is no such thing as negative
goodness, is in this chapter shown three times:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxvii-p20">1. In the parable of the virgins;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxvii-p21">2. In the still plainer parable of the
servants, who had received the talents; and</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxvii-p22">3. In a direct unparabolical declaration of
the manner wherein our Lord will proceed at the last day. The several
parts of each of these exactly answers each other, only each rises above
the preceding.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p23">31. When the Son of man shall come in his glory, and all
the holy angels with him - With what majesty and grandeur does our Lord
here speak of himself Giving us one of the noblest instances of the true
sublime. Indeed not many descriptions in the sacred writings themselves
seem to equal this. Methinks we can hardly read it without imagining
ourselves before the awful tribunal it describes.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p24">34. Inherit the kingdom - Purchased by my blood, for all
who have believed in me with the faith which wrought by love. Prepared
for you - On purpose for you. May it not be probably inferred from
hence, that man was not created merely to fill up the places of the
fallen angels?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p25">35. I was hungry, and ye gave me meat; I was thirsty, and
ye gave me drink - All these works of outward mercy suppose faith and
love, and must needs he accompanied with works of spiritual mercy. But
works of this kind the Judge could not mention in the same manner. He
could not say, I was in error, and ye recalled me to the truth; I was in
sin, and ye brought me to repentance. In prison - Prisoners need to be
visited above all others, as they are commonly solitary and forsaken by
the rest of the world.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p26">37. Then shall the righteous answer - It cannot be, that
either the righteous or the wicked should answer in these very words.
What we learn herefrom is, that neither of them have the same estimation
of their own works as the Judge hath.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p27">40. Inasmuch as ye did it to one of the least of these my
brethren, ye did it to me - What encouragement is here to assist the
household of faith? But let us likewise remember to do good to all
men.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p28">41. Depart into the everlasting fire, which was prepared
for the devil and his angels - Not originally for you: you are intruders
into everlasting fire.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p29">44. Then will they answer - So the endeavour to justify
themselves, will remain with the wicked even to that day!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxvii-p30">46. And these shall go away into everlasting punishment,
but the righteous into life everlasting - Either therefore the
punishment is strictly eternal, or the reward is not: the very same
expression being applied to the former as to the latter. The Judge will
speak first to the righteous, in the audience of the wicked. The wicked
shall then go away into everlasting fire, in the view of the righteous.
Thus the damned shall see nothing of the everlasting life; but the just
will see the punishment of the ungodly. It is not only particularly
observable here</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxvii-p31">1. That the punishment lasts as long as the
reward; but,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ii.xxvii-p32">2. That this punishment is so far from
ceasing at the end of the world, that it does not begin till then.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="3.43%" prev="i.ii.xxvii" next="i.ii.xxix" id="i.ii.xxviii">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxviii-p0.1">XXVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xxvi" id="i.ii.xxviii-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p1">1. When Jesus had finished all these discourses - When he
had spoken all he had to speak. Till then he would not enter upon his
passion: then he would delay it no longer. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 1" id="i.ii.xxviii-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.1">Mark xiv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 1" id="i.ii.xxviii-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|22|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.1">Luke xxii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p2">2. After two days is the Passover - The manner wherein this
was celebrated gives much light to several circumstances that follow.
The master of the family began the feast with a cup of wine, which
having solemnly blessed, he divided among the guests, <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 17" id="i.ii.xxviii-p2.1" parsed="|Luke|22|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.17">Luke xxii, 17</scripRef>. Then the supper began with the unleavened bread and bitter
herbs; which when they had all tasted, one of the young persons present,
according to <scripRef passage="Exod. xii. 26" id="i.ii.xxviii-p2.2" parsed="|Exod|12|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12.26">Exod. xii, 26</scripRef>, asked the reason of the solemnity. This introduced the
showing forth, or declaration of it: in allusion to which we read of
showing forth the Lord's death, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. xi. 26" id="i.ii.xxviii-p2.3" parsed="|1Cor|11|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.11.26">1 Cor. xi,
26</scripRef>. Then the master rose up and took another cup, before the
lamb was tasted. After supper, he took a thin loaf or cake, which he
broke and divided to all at the table, and likewise the cup, usually
called the cup of thanksgiving, of which he drank first, and then all
the guests. It was this bread and this cup which our Lord consecrated to
be a standing memorial of his death.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p3">3. The chief priests and the scribes and the elders of the
people - (Heads of families.) These together constituted the sanhedrim,
or great council, which had the supreme authority, both in civil and
ecclesiastical affairs.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p4">5. But they said, Not at the feast - This was the result of
human wisdom. But when Judas came they changed their purpose. So the
counsel of God took place, and the true paschal Lamb was offered up on
the great day of the paschal solemnity.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p5">6. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 3" id="i.ii.xxviii-p5.1" parsed="|Mark|14|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.3">Mark xiv,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p6">8. His disciples seeing it, had indignation, saying - It
seems several of them were angry, and spoke, though none so warmly as
Judas Iscariot.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p7">11. Ye have the poor always with you - Such is the wise and
gracious providence of God, that we may have always opportunities of
relieving their wants, and so laying up for ourselves treasures in
heaven.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p8">12. She hath done it for my burial - As it were for the
embalming of my body. Indeed this was not her design: but our Lord puts
this construction upon it, to confirm thereby what he had before said to
his disciples, concerning his approaching death.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p9">13. This Gospel - That is, this part of the Gospel
history.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p10">14. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 10" id="i.ii.xxviii-p10.1" parsed="|Mark|14|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.10">Mark xiv,
10</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 3" id="i.ii.xxviii-p10.2" parsed="|Luke|22|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.3">Luke xxii,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p11">15. They bargained with him for thirty pieces of silver -
(About three pounds fifteen shillings sterling; or sixteen dollars
sixty- seven cents) the price of a slave, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxi. 32" id="i.ii.xxviii-p11.1" parsed="|Exod|21|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.21.32">Exod. xxi, 32</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p12">17. On the first day of unleavened bread - Being Thursday,
the fourteenth day of the first month, <scripRef passage="Exod. xii. 6, 15" id="i.ii.xxviii-p12.1" parsed="|Exod|12|6|0|0;|Exod|12|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12.6 Bible:Exod.12.15">Exod. xii, 6, 15</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 12" id="i.ii.xxviii-p12.2" parsed="|Mark|14|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.12">Mark xiv, 12</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 7" id="i.ii.xxviii-p12.3" parsed="|Luke|22|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.7">Luke xxii, 7</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p13">18. The Master saith, My time is at hand - That is, the
time of my suffering.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p14">20. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 17" id="i.ii.xxviii-p14.1" parsed="|Mark|14|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.17">Mark xiv,
17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 14" id="i.ii.xxviii-p14.2" parsed="|Luke|22|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.14">Luke xxii,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p15">23. He that dippeth his hand with me in the dish - Which it
seems Judas was doing at that very time. This dish was a vessel full of
vinegar, wherein they dipped their bitter herbs.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p16">24. The Son of man goeth through sufferings to glory, as it
is written of him - Yet this is no excuse for him that betrayeth him:
miserable will that man be: it had been good for that man if he had not
been born - May not the same be said of every man that finally perishes?
But who can reconcile this, if it were true of Judas alone, with the
doctrine of universal salvation?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p17">25. Thou hast said - That is, it is as thou hast said.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p18">26. Jesus took the bread - the bread or cake, which the
master of the family used to divide among them, after they had eaten the
passover. The custom our Lord now transferred to a nobler use. This
bread is, that is, signifies or represents my body, according to the
style of the sacred writers. Thus <scripRef passage="Gen. xl. 12" id="i.ii.xxviii-p18.1" parsed="|Gen|40|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.40.12">Gen.
xl, 12</scripRef>, The three branches are three days. Thus <scripRef passage="Gal. iv. 24" id="i.ii.xxviii-p18.2" parsed="|Gal|4|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.4.24">Gal. iv, 24</scripRef>, St. Paul speaking of Sarah and Hagar, says, These are the
two covenants. Thus in the grand type of our Lord, <scripRef passage="Exod. xii. 11" id="i.ii.xxviii-p18.3" parsed="|Exod|12|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12.11">Exod. xii,
11</scripRef>, God says of the paschal lamb, This is the Lord's passover.
Now Christ substituting the holy communion for the passover, follows the
style of the Old Testament, and uses the same expressions the Jews were
wont to use in celebrating the passover.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p19">27. And he took the cup - Called by the Jews the cup of
thanksgiving; which the master of the family used likewise to give to
each after supper.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p20">28. This is the sign of my blood, whereby the new testament
or covenant is confirmed. Which is shed for many - As many as spring
from Adam.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p21">29. I will not drink henceforth of this fruit of the vine,
till I drink it new with you in my Father's kingdom - That is, I shall
taste no more wine, till I drink wine of quite another kind in the
glorious kingdom of my Father. And of this you shall also partake with
me.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p22">30. And when they had sung the hymn - Which was constantly
sung at the close of the passover. It consisteth of six psalms, from the
113th to the 118th. The Mount of Olives - Was over against the temple,
about two miles from Jerusalem. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 26" id="i.ii.xxviii-p22.1" parsed="|Mark|14|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.26">Mark
xiv, 26</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 39" id="i.ii.xxviii-p22.2" parsed="|Luke|22|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.39">Luke xxii, 39</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 1" id="i.ii.xxviii-p22.3" parsed="|John|18|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.1">John xviii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p23">31. All ye will be offended at me - Something will happen
to me, which will occasion your falling into sin by forsaking me. <scripRef passage="Zech. xiii. 7" id="i.ii.xxviii-p23.1" parsed="|Zech|13|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.13.7">Zech. xiii, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p24">32. But notwithstanding this, after I am risen I will go
before you (as a shepherd before his sheep) into Galilee. Though you
forsake me, I will not for this forsake you.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p25">34. Before cock crowing thou wilt deny me thrice - That is,
before three in the morning, the usual time of cock crowing: although
one cock was heard to crow once, after Peter's first denial of his
Lord.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p26">35. In like manner also said all the disciples - But such
was the tenderness of our Lord, that he would not aggravate their sin by
making any reply.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p27">36. Then cometh Jesus to a place called Gethsemane - That
is, the valley of fatness. The garden probably had its name from its
soil and situation, laying in some little valley between two of those
many hills, the range of which constitutes the Mount of Olives. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 32" id="i.ii.xxviii-p27.1" parsed="|Mark|14|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.32">Mark xiv, 32</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 40" id="i.ii.xxviii-p27.2" parsed="|Luke|22|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.40">Luke xxii, 40</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p28">37. And taking with him Peter and the two sons of Zebedee -
To be witnesses of all; he began to be sorrowful and in deep anguish -
Probably from feeling the arrows of the Almighty stick fast in his soul,
while God laid on him the iniquities of us all. Who can tell what
painful and dreadful sensations were then impressed on him by the
immediate hand of God? The former word in the original properly
signifies, to be penetrated with the most exquisite sorrow; the latter
to be quite depressed, and almost overwhelmed with the load.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p29">39. And going a little farther - About a stone's cast, <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 41" id="i.ii.xxviii-p29.1" parsed="|Luke|22|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.41">Luke xxii, 41</scripRef> - So that the apostles could both see and hear him still. If
it be possible, let this cup pass from me - And it did pass from him
quickly. When he cried unto God with strong cries and tears, he was
heard in that which he feared. God did take away the terror and severity
of that inward conflict.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p30">41. The spirit - Your spirit: ye yourselves. The flesh -
Your nature. How gentle a rebuke was this, and how kind an apology!
especially at a time when our Lord's own mind was so weighed down with
sorrow.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p31">45. Sleep on now, if you can, and take your rest - For any
farther service you can be of to me.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p32">47. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 43" id="i.ii.xxviii-p32.1" parsed="|Mark|14|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.43">Mark xiv,
43</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 47" id="i.ii.xxviii-p32.2" parsed="|Luke|22|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.47">Luke xxii,
47</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 2" id="i.ii.xxviii-p32.3" parsed="|John|18|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.2">John xviii,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p33">50. The heroic behaviour of the blessed Jesus, in the whole
period of his sufferings, will be observed by every attentive eye, and
felt by every pious heart: although the sacred historians, according to
their usual but wonderful simplicity, make no encomiums upon it. With
what composure does he go forth to meet the traitor! With what calmness
receive that malignant kiss! With what dignity does he deliver himself
into the hands of his enemies! Yet plainly showing his superiority over
them, and even then leading as it were captivity captive!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p34">51. And one of them striking the servant of the high priest
- Probably the person that seized Jesus first; Cut off his ear - Aiming,
it seems, to cleave his head, but that by a secret providence
interposing, he declined the blow. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 47" id="i.ii.xxviii-p34.1" parsed="|Mark|14|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.47">Mark
xiv, 47</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 49" id="i.ii.xxviii-p34.2" parsed="|Luke|22|49|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.49">Luke xxii, 49</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 10" id="i.ii.xxviii-p34.3" parsed="|John|18|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.10">John xviii, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p35">52. All they that take the sword - Without God's giving it
them: without sufficient authority.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p36">53. He will presently give me more than twelve legions of
angels - The least of whom, it is probable, could overturn the earth and
destroy all the inhabitants of it.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p37">55. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 48" id="i.ii.xxviii-p37.1" parsed="|Mark|14|48|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.48">Mark xiv,
48</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 52" id="i.ii.xxviii-p37.2" parsed="|Luke|22|52|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.52">Luke xxii,
52</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p38">57. They led him away to Caiaphas - From the house of
Annas, the father-in-law of Caiaphas, to whom they had carried him
first. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 53" id="i.ii.xxviii-p38.1" parsed="|Mark|14|53|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.53">Mark xiv, 53</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 54" id="i.ii.xxviii-p38.2" parsed="|Luke|22|54|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.54">Luke xxii, 54</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 12" id="i.ii.xxviii-p38.3" parsed="|John|18|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.12">John xviii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p39">58. But Peter followed him afar off - Variously agitated by
conflicting passions; love constrained him to follow his Master; fear
made him follow afar off. And going in, sat with the servants - Unfit
companions as the event showed.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p40">60. Yet found they none - On whose evidence they could
condemn him to die. At last came two false witnesses - Such they were,
although part of what they said was true; because our Lord did not speak
some of those words at all; nor any of them in this sense.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p41">64. Hereafter shall ye see the Son of man - He speaks in
the third person, modestly, and yet plainly; Sitting on the right hand
of power - That is, the right hand of God: And coming upon the clouds of
heaven - As he is represented by Daniel, <scripRef passage="Dan. vii. 13, 14" id="i.ii.xxviii-p41.1" parsed="|Dan|7|13|7|14" osisRef="Bible:Dan.7.13-Dan.7.14">Dan. vii, 13, 14</scripRef>. Our Lord looked very unlike that person now! But nothing
could be more awful, more majestic and becoming, than such an admonition
in such circumstances!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p42">65. Then the high priest rent his clothes - Though the high
priest was forbidden to rend his clothes (that is, his upper garment) in
some cases where others were allowed to do it, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxi. 10" id="i.ii.xxviii-p42.1" parsed="|Lev|21|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.21.10">Lev. xxi, 10</scripRef>; yet in case of blasphemy or any public calamity, it was
thought allowable. Caiaphas hereby expressed, in the most artful manner,
his horror at hearing such grievous blasphemy.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p43">67. Then - After he had declared he was the Son of God, the
sanhedrim doubtless ordered him to be carried out, while they were
consulting what to do. And then it was that the soldiers who kept him
began these insults upon him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p44">72. He denied with an oath - To which possibly he was not
unaccustomed, before our Lord called him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p45">73. Surely thou art also one of them, for thy speech
discovereth thee - Malchus might have brought a stronger proof than
this. But such is the overruling providence of God, that the world, in
the height of their zeal, commonly catch hold of the very weakest of all
arguments against the children of God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxviii-p46">74. Then began he to curse and to swear - Having now quite
lost the reins, the government of himself.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="3.62%" prev="i.ii.xxviii" next="i.ii.xxx" id="i.ii.xxix">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxix-p0.1">XXVII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xxvii" id="i.ii.xxix-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p1">1. In the morning - As the sanhedrim used to meet in one of
the courts of the temple, which was never opened in the night, they were
forced to stay till the morning before they could proceed regularly, in
the resolution they had taken to put him to death. <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 1" id="i.ii.xxix-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|15|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.1">Mark xv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 66; xxiii. 1" id="i.ii.xxix-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|22|66|0|0;|Luke|23|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.66 Bible:Luke.23.1">Luke xxii, 66; xxiii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 28" id="i.ii.xxix-p1.3" parsed="|John|18|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.28">John xviii,
28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p2">2. Having bound him - They had bound him when he was first
apprehended. But they did it now afresh, to secure him from any danger
of an escape, as he passed through the streets of Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p3">3. Then Judas seeing that he was condemned - Which probably
he thought Christ would have prevented by a miracle.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p4">4. They said, what is that to us? - How easily could they
digest innocent blood! And yet they had a conscience! It is not lawful
(say they) to put it into the treasury - But very lawful to slay the
innocent!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p5">5. In that part of the temple where the sanhedrim met.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p6">7. They bought with them the potter's field - Well known,
it seems, by that name. This was a small price for a field so near
Jerusalem. But the earth had probably been digged for potters' vessels,
so that it was now neither fit for tillage nor pasture, and consequently
of small value. Foreigners - Heathens especially, of whom there were
then great numbers in Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p7">9. Then was fulfilled - What was figuratively represented
of old, was now really accomplished. What was spoken by the prophet -
The word Jeremy, which was added to the text in latter copies, and
thence received into many translations, is evidently a mistake: for he
who spoke what St. Matthew here cites (or rather paraphrases) was not
Jeremy, but Zechariah. <scripRef passage="Zech. xi. 12" id="i.ii.xxix-p7.1" parsed="|Zech|11|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.11.12">Zech. xi,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p8">10. As the Lord commanded me - To write, to record.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p9">11. Art thou the king of the Jews? - Jesus before Caiaphas
avows himself to be the Christ, before Pilate to be a king; clearly
showing thereby, that his answering no more, was not owing to any
fear.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p10">15. At every feast - Every year, at the feast of the
passover. <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 6" id="i.ii.xxix-p10.1" parsed="|Mark|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.6">Mark xv, 6</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 17" id="i.ii.xxix-p10.2" parsed="|Luke|23|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.17">Luke
xxiii, 17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 39" id="i.ii.xxix-p10.3" parsed="|John|18|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.39">John xviii,
39</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p11">18. He knew that for envy they had delivered him - As well
as from malice and revenge; they envied him, because the people
magnified him.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p12">22. They all say, Let him be crucified - The punishment
which Barabbas had deserved: and this probably made them think of it.
But in their malice they forgot with how dangerous a precedent they
furnished the Roman governor. And indeed within the compass of a few
years it turned dreadfully upon themselves.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p13">24. Then Pilate took water and washed his hands - This was
a custom frequently used among the heathens as well as among the Jews,
in token of innocency.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p14">25. His blood be on us and on our children - As this
imprecation was dread. fully answered in the ruin so quickly brought on
the Jewish nation, and the calamities which have ever since pursued that
wretched people, so it was peculiarly fulfilled by Titus the Roman
general, on the Jews whom he took during the siege of Jerusalem. So
many, after having been scourged in a terrible manner, were crucified
all round the city, that in a while there was not room near the wall for
the crosses to stand by each other. Probably this befell some of those
who now joined in this cry, as it certainly did many of their children:
the very finger of God thus pointing out their crime in crucifying his
Son.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p15">26. He delivered him to be crucified - The person crucified
was nailed to the cross as it lay on the ground, through each hand
extended to the utmost stretch, and through both the feet together. Then
the cross was raised up, and the foot of it thrust with a violent shock
into a hole in the ground prepared for it. This shock disjointed the
body, whose whole weight hung upon the nails, till the persons expired
through mere dint of pain. This kind of death was used only by the
Romans, and by them inflicted only on slaves and the vilest
criminals.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p16">27. The whole troop - or cohort. This was a body of foot
commanded by the governor, which was appointed to prevent disorders and
tumults, especially on solemn occasions. <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 16" id="i.ii.xxix-p16.1" parsed="|Mark|15|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.16">Mark xv, 16</scripRef> <scripRef passage="John xix. 2" id="i.ii.xxix-p16.2" parsed="|John|19|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.2">John xix,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p17">28. They put on him a scarlet robe - Such as kings and
generals wore; probably an old tattered one.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p18">32. Him they compelled to bear his cross - He bore it
himself, till he sunk under it, <scripRef passage="John xix. 17" id="i.ii.xxix-p18.1" parsed="|John|19|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.17">John
xix, 17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p19">33. A place called Golgotha, that is, the place of a skull
- Golgotha in Syriac signifies a skull or head: it was probably called
so from this time; being an eminence upon Mount Calvary, not far from
the king's gardens. <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 22" id="i.ii.xxix-p19.1" parsed="|Mark|15|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.22">Mark xv,
22</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 33" id="i.ii.xxix-p19.2" parsed="|Luke|23|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.33">Luke xxiii,
33</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 17" id="i.ii.xxix-p19.3" parsed="|John|19|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.17">John xix,
17</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p20">34. They gave him vinegar mingled with gall - Out of
derision: which, however nauseous, he received and tasted of. St. Mark
mentions also a different mixture which was given him, Wine mingled with
myrrh: such as it was customary to give to dying criminals, to make them
less sensible of their sufferings: but this our Lord refused to taste,
determining to bear the full force of his pains.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p21">35. They parted his garments - This was the custom of the
Romams. The soldiers performed the office of executioners, and divided
among them the spoils of the criminals. My vesture - That is, my inner
garment. <scripRef passage="Psalm xxii. 18" id="i.ii.xxix-p21.1" parsed="|Ps|22|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.22.18">Psalm xxii,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p22">38. <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 27" id="i.ii.xxix-p22.1" parsed="|Mark|15|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.27">Mark xv, 27</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 32" id="i.ii.xxix-p22.2" parsed="|Luke|23|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.32">Luke xxiii, 32</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p23">44. <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 32" id="i.ii.xxix-p23.1" parsed="|Mark|15|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.32">Mark xv, 32</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 33" id="i.ii.xxix-p23.2" parsed="|Luke|23|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.33">Luke xxiii, 33</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p24">45. From the sixth hour, there was darkness over all the
earth unto the ninth hour - Insomuch, that even a heathen philosopher
seeing it, and knowing it could not be a natural eclipse, because it was
at the time of the full moon, and continued three hours together, cried
out, "Either the God of nature suffers, or the frame of the world is
dissolved." By this darkness God testified his abhorrence of the
wickedness which was then committing. It likewise intimated Christ's
sore conflicts with the Divine justice, and with all the powers of
darkness.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p25">46. About the ninth hour, Jesus cried with a loud voice -
Our Lord's great agony probably continued these three whole hours, at
the conclusion of which be thus cried out, while he suffered from God
himself what was unutterable. My God, my God, why hast thou forsaken me?
- Our Lord hereby at once expresses his trust in God, and a most
distressing sense of his letting loose the powers of darkness upon him,
withdrawing the comfortable discoveries of his presence, and filling his
soul with a terrible sense of the wrath due to the sins which he was
bearing. <scripRef passage="Psalm xxii. 1" id="i.ii.xxix-p25.1" parsed="|Ps|22|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.22.1">Psalm xxii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p26">48. One taking a sponge, filled it with vinegar - Vinegar
and water was the usual drink of the Roman soldiers. It does not appear,
that this was given him in derision, but rather with a friendly design,
that he might not die before Elijah came. <scripRef passage="John xix. 28" id="i.ii.xxix-p26.1" parsed="|John|19|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.28">John xix, 28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p27">50. After he had cried with a loud voice - To show that his
life was still whole in him. He dismissed his spirit - So the original
expression may be literally translated: an expression admirably suited
to our Lord's words, John x, xviii, No man taketh my life from me, but I
lay it down of myself. He died by a voluntary act of his own, and in a
way peculiar to himself. He alone of all men that ever were, could have
continued alive even in the greatest tortures, as long as he pleased, or
have retired from the body whenever he had thought fit. And how does it
illustrate that love which he manifested in his death? Insomuch as he
did not use his power to quit his body, as soon as it was fastened to
the cross, leaving only an insensible corpse, to the cruelty of his
murderers: but continued his abode in it, with a steady resolution, as
long as it was proper. He then retired from it, with a majesty and
dignity never known or to be known in any other death: dying, if one may
so express it, like the Prince of life.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p28">51. Immediately upon his death, while the sun was still
darkened, the veil of the temple, which separated the holy of holies
from the court of the priests, though made of the richest and strongest
tapestry, was rent in two from the top to the bottom: so that while the
priest was ministering at the golden altar (it being the time of the
sacrifice) the sacred oracle, by an invisible power was laid open to
full view: God thereby signifying the speedy removal of the veil of the
Jewish ceremonies the casting down the partition wall, so that the Jews
and Gentiles were now admitted to equal privileges, and the opening a
way through the veil of his flesh for all believers into the most holy
place. And the earth was shaken - There was a general earthquake through
the whole globe, though chiefly near Jerusalem: God testifying thereby
his wrath against the Jewish nation, for the horrid impiety they were
committing.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p29">52. Some of the tombs were shattered and laid open by the
earthquake, and while they continued unclosed (and they must have stood
open all the Sabbath, seeing the law would not allow any attempt to
close them) many bodies of holy men were raised, (perhaps Simeon,
Zacharias, John the Baptist, and others who had believed in Christ, and
were known to many in Jerusalem, ) And coming out of the tombs after his
resurrection, went into the holy city (Jerusalem) and appeared to many -
Who had probably known them before: God hereby signifying, that Christ
had conquered death, and would raise all his saints in due season.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p30">54. The centurion - The officer who commanded the guard;
and they that were with him feared, saying, Truly this was the Son of
God - Referring to the words of the chief priests and scribes, chap.
xxvii, xliii, He said, I am the Son of God.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p31">56. James - The less: he was so called, to distinguish him
from the other James, the brother of John; probably because he was less
in stature.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p32">57. When the evening was come - That is, after three
o'clock; the time from three to six they termed the evening. <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 42" id="i.ii.xxix-p32.1" parsed="|Mark|15|42|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.42">Mark xv, 42</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 50" id="i.ii.xxix-p32.2" parsed="|Luke|23|50|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.50">Luke xxiii, 50</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 38" id="i.ii.xxix-p32.3" parsed="|John|19|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.38">John xix, 38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p33">62. On the morrow, the day that followed the day of the
preparation - The day of preparation was the day before the Sabbath,
whereon they were to prepare for the celebration of it. The next day
then was the Sabbath according to the Jews. But the evangelist seems to
express it by this circumlocution, to show the Jewish Sabbath was then
abolished.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p34">63. That impostor said, while he was yet alive, After three
days I will rise again - We do not find that he had ever said this to
them, unless when he spoke of the temple of his body, <scripRef passage="John ii. 19, 21" id="i.ii.xxix-p34.1" parsed="|John|2|19|0|0;|John|2|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.2.19 Bible:John.2.21">John ii, 19, 21</scripRef>. And if they here refer to what he then said, how perverse
and iniquitous was their construction on these words, when he was on his
trial before the council? Chap. xxvi, 61. Then they seemed not to
understand them!</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p35">65. Ye have a guard - Of your own, in the tower of Antonia,
which was stationed there for the service of the temple.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxix-p36">66. They went and secured the sepulchre, sealing the stone,
and setting a guard - They set Pilate's signet, or the public seal of
the sanhedrim upon a fastening which they had put on the stone. And all
this uncommon caution was overruled by the providence of God, to give
the strongest proofs of Christ's ensuing resurrection; since there could
be no room for the least suspicion of deceit, when it should be found,
that his body was raised out of a new tomb, where there was no other
corpse, and this tomb hewn out of a rock, the mouth of which was secured
by a great stone, under a seal, and a guard of soldiers.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVIII" progress="3.81%" prev="i.ii.xxix" next="i.iii" id="i.ii.xxx">
<h3 id="i.ii.xxx-p0.1">XXVIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Matt. xxviii" id="i.ii.xxx-p0.2" parsed="|Matt|28|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.28" /> 

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Mark xvi. 1" id="i.ii.xxx-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|16|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.16.1">Mark xvi, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 1" id="i.ii.xxx-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.1">Luke xxiv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xx. 1" id="i.ii.xxx-p1.3" parsed="|John|20|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.1">John xx, 1</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p2">2. An angel of the Lord had rolled away the stone and sat
upon it - St. Luke and St. John speak of two angels that appeared: but
it seems as if only one of them had appeared sitting on the stone
without the sepulchre, and then going into it, was seen with another
angel, sitting, one where the head, the other where the feet of the body
had lain.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p3">6. Come, see the place where the Lord lay - Probably in
speaking he rose up, and going before the women into the sepulchre,
said, Come, see the place. This clearly reconciles what St. John
relates, <scripRef passage="John xx. 12" id="i.ii.xxx-p3.1" parsed="|John|20|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.12">John xx, 12</scripRef>, this being one of the two angels there mentioned.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p4">7. There shall ye see him - In his solemn appearance to
them all together. But their gracious Lord would not be absent so long:
he appeared to them several times before then. Lo, I have told you - A
solemn confirmation of what he had said.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p5">9. Hail - The word in its primary sense means, "Rejoice:"
in its secondary and more usual meaning, "Happiness attend you."</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p6">10. Go tell my brethren -- I still own them as such, though
they so lately disowned and forsook me.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p7">13. Say, his disciples came by night, and stole him while
we slept - Is it possible, that any man of sense should digest this
poor, shallow inconsistency? If ye were awake, why did you let the
disciples steal him? If asleep, how do you know they did?</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p8">16. To the mountain where Jesus had appointed them - This
was probably Mount Tabor, where, (it is commonly supposed) he had been
before transfigured. It seems to have been here also, that he appeared
to above five hundred brethren at once.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p9">18. All power is given to me - Even as man. As God, he had
all power from eternity.</p>

<p id="i.ii.xxx-p10">19. Disciple all nations - Make them my disciples. This
includes the whole design of Christ's commission. Baptizing and teaching
are the two great branches of that general design. And these were to be
determined by the circumstances of things; which made it necessary in
baptizing adult Jews or heathens, to teach them before they were
baptized; in discipling their children, to baptize them before they were
taught; as the Jewish children in all ages were first circumcised, and
after taught to do all God had commanded them. <scripRef passage="Mark xvi. 15" id="i.ii.xxx-p10.1" parsed="|Mark|16|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.16.15">Mark xvi, 15</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE GOSPEL ACCORDING TO ST. MARK" progress="3.85%" prev="i.ii.xxx" next="i.iii.i" id="i.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark" id="i.iii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.iii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE GOSPEL ACCORDING TO ST. MARK</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Mark" progress="3.85%" prev="i.iii" next="i.iii.ii" id="i.iii.i">

<p id="i.iii.i-p1">THIS CONTAINS,</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.iii.i-p2">I. The beginning of the Gospel,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iii.i-p3">a. John prepares the way Chap. i, 1-8</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iii.i-p4">b. Baptizes Jesus, who is proclaimed the Son
of God 9-11</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iii.i-p5">c. Tempted of Satan, served by angels 12,
13</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.iii.i-p6">II. The Gospel itself,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iii.i-p7">A. In Galilee: where we may observe three
periods,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iii.i-p8">a. After John was cast into prison, In
general,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p9">1. The place and matter of his preaching, 14,
15</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p10">2. The calling of several of the apostles
16-20 In particular,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p11">1. Actions not censured by his
adversaries</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p12">1. He teaches with authority 21, 22</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p13">2. Cures the demoniac 23-28</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p14">3. Heals many sick 29-34</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p15">4. Prays 35</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p16">5. Teaches everywhere 36-39</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p17">6. Cleanses the leper 40-45</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p18">2. Actions censured by them, Here occur,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p19">1. The paralytic forgiven and healed ii,
1-12</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p20">2. The call of Levi, and eating with
publicans and sinners. 13-17</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p21">3. The question concerning fasting answered
18-22</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p22">4. The ears of corn plucked 23-28</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p23">5. The withered hand restored: Snares laid
iii, 1-6</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p24">3. Our Lord's retirement,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p25">1. At the sea 7-12</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p26">2. In the mountain, where the apostles are
called 13-19</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p27">3. In the house, where after refuting the
blasphemy of the Pharisees, he shows who are his mother and his
brethren. 20-35</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p28">4. In the ship; various parables iv, 1-34</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p29">5. On the sea, and beyond it 35-41 v,
1-20</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p30">6. On this side the sea: Again: Jairus, and
the woman with the flux of blood 21-43</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p31">7. At Nazareth: His countrymen offended vi,
1-6</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p32">8. The apostles sent forth 7-13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iii.i-p33">b. After John was put to death,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p34">1. Herod's hearing of Jesus, and judgment of
him 14-29</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p35">2. Christ's retiring with his apostles, now
returned 30-32</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p36">3. The earnestness of the people; Christ's
compassion; five thousand fed 33-44</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p37">4. His walking on the sea 45-52</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p38">5. He heals many in the land of Gennesaret
53-56</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p39">6. And teaches what defiles a man vii,
1-23</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p40">7. A devil cast out in the coasts of Tyre and
Sidon 24-30</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p41">8. At the sea of Galilee, the deaf and dumb
healed; four thousand fed 31-37 viii, 1-9</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p42">9. He comes into the parts of Dalmanutha, and
answers concerning the sign from heaven Chap. viii, 10-13</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p43">10. In the ship, he warns them of evil leaven
14-21</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p44">11. At Bethsaida, heals the sick 22-26</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iii.i-p45">c. After he was acknowledged to be the Son of
God,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p46">1. Peter confessing him, he enjoins his
disciples silence; foretells his passion; reproves Peter; exhorts to
follow him 21 ix, 1</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p47">2. Is transfigured: casts out a devil;
foretells his passion. 2-32</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p48">3. Reproves and instructs his disciples
33-50</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iii.i-p49">B. In Judea,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iii.i-p50">a. In the borders x, 1</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p51">1. He treats of divorce 2-12</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p52">2. Of little children 13-16</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p53">3. Of entering into life, and of the danger
of riches 17-31</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iii.i-p54">b. In his way to the city,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p55">1. He foretells his passion a third time
32-34</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p56">2. Answers James and John, and instructs them
all 35-45</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p57">3. At Jericho, gives sight to Bartimeus
46-52</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iii.i-p58">4. At Jerusalem xi, 1</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p59">a. His royal entry' 2-11</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p60">b. The day after, the fig tree cursed 12-14
the temple purged 15- 19</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p61">c. The day after that,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p62">1. Near the fig tree, he shows the power of
faith 20-26</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p63">2. In the temple,</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p64">1. His authority vindicated 27-33</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p65">2. The parable of the wicked husbandmen xii,
1-12</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p66">3. Of paying tribute to Caesar 13-17</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p67">4. Of the resurrection 18-27</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p68">5. Of the great commandment 28-34</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p69">6. Of David's Lord 35-37</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p70">7. He warns the people of the scribes
38-40</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p71">8. Commends the poor widow 41-44</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p72">3. On Mount Olivet, he foretells the
destruction of the city and temple, and the end of the world xiii,
1-37</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p73">d. Two days before the passover; his enemies
bargain with Judas. xiv, 1-11</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p74">e. On the first day of unleavened bread,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p75">1. The passover prepared 12-16</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p76">2. The Lord's Supper instituted 17-25</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p77">3. After the hymn, the offense of the
disciples and Peter's denial foretold 26-31</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p78">4. In Gethsemane, Jesus prays; wakes his
disciples 32-42 is betrayed; taken; forsaken of all 43-52</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p79">5. In the high priest's palace, He is
condemned to death 53-65 Denied by Peter 66-72</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p80">f. Friday, What was done,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p81">1.In Pilate's palace xv, 1-20</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p82">2. In the way 21</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p83">3. At Golgotha 22</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p84">1. The wine and myrrh offered 23</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p85">2. The crucifixion; his garments parted 24,
25</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p86">3. The title 26</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p87">4. The two malefactors 27, 28</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p88">5. Revilings 29-32</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p89">6. The darkness; the cry of Jesus; the scoff;
the vinegar; his death; the veil rent 33-38</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iii.i-p90">7. The saying of the centurion; the women
looking on 39-41</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p91">4. In the evening, the burial 42-47</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iii.i-p92">g. Sunday, Our Lord's resurrection
declared,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p93">1. By an angel Chap. xvi, 1-8</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iii.i-p94">2. By himself, To Mary Magdalene 9-11 To two
going into the country 12, 13 To the eleven sitting at meat 14</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.iii.i-p95">III. The Gospel,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iii.i-p96">1. Committed by Christ to apostles after his
resurrection. 15-18</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iii.i-p97">2. Confirmed after his ascension 19, 20</p>
<h2 id="i.iii.i-p97.1">MARK</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="3.93%" prev="i.iii.i" next="i.iii.iii" id="i.iii.ii">
<h3 id="i.iii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark I" id="i.iii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1" /> 

<p id="i.iii.ii-p1">1. The beginning of the Gospel of Jesus Christ - The
evangelist speaks with strict propriety: for the beginning of the Gospel
is in the account of John the Baptist, contained in the first paragraph;
the Gospel itself in the rest of the book. <scripRef passage="Matt. iii. 1" id="i.iii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.3.1">Matt. iii, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iii. 1" id="i.iii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3.1">Luke iii, 1</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p2">2. <scripRef passage="Mal. iii. 1" id="i.iii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Mal|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mal.3.1">Mal. iii,
1</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p3">3. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 3" id="i.iii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Isa|40|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.3">Isaiah xl,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p4">4. Preaching the baptism of repentance - That is, preaching
repentance, and baptizing as a sign and means of it.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p5">7. The latchet of whose shoes I am not worthy to unloose -
That is, to do him the very meanest service.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p6">9. <scripRef passage="Matt. iii. 13" id="i.iii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|3|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.3.13">Matt. iii,
13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iii. 21" id="i.iii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Luke|3|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3.21">Luke iii,
21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p7">12. And immediately the Spirit thrusteth him out into the
wilderness - So in all the children of God, extraordinary manifestations
of his favour are wont to be followed by extraordinary temptations. <scripRef passage="Matt. iv. 1" id="i.iii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|4|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4.1">Matt. iv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 1" id="i.iii.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Luke|4|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.1">Luke iv, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p8">13. And he was there forty days, tempted by Satan -
Invisibly. After this followed the temptation by him in a visible shape,
related by St. Matthew. And he was with the wild beasts - Though they
had no power to hurt him. St. Mark not only gives us a compendium of St.
Matthew's Gospel, but likewise several valuable particulars, which the
other evangelists have omitted.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p9">14. <scripRef passage="Matt. iv. 12" id="i.iii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|4|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4.12">Matt. iv,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p10">15. The time is fulfilled - The time of my kingdom,
foretold by Daniel, expected by you, is fully come.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p11">16. <scripRef passage="Matt. iv. 18" id="i.iii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|4|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4.18">Matt. iv,
18</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 1" id="i.iii.ii-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|5|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.1">Luke v, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p12">18. Straightway leaving their nets, they followed him -
From this time they forsook their employ, and constantly attended him.
Happy they who follow Christ at the first call!</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p13">21. <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 31" id="i.iii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Luke|4|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.31">Luke iv,
31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p14">26. A loud noise - For he was forbidden to speak. Christ
would neither suffer those evil spirits to speak in opposition, nor yet
in favour of him. He needed not their testimony, nor would encourage it,
lest any should infer that he acted in concert with them.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p15">29. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 14" id="i.iii.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|8|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.14">Matt. viii,
14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 38" id="i.iii.ii-p15.2" parsed="|Luke|4|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.38">Luke iv,
38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p16">32. When the sun was set - And, consequently, the Sabbath
was ended, which they reckoned from sunset to sunset.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p17">33. And the whole city was gathered together at the door -
O what a fair prospect was here! Who could then have imagined that all
these blossoms would die away without fruit?</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p18">34. He suffered not the devils to say that they knew him -
That is, according to Dr. Mead's hypothesis, (that the Scriptural
demoniacs were only diseased persons) He suffered not the diseases to
say that they knew him!</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p19">35. Rising a great while before day - So did he labour for
us, both day and night. <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 42" id="i.iii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Luke|4|42|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.42">Luke iv,
42</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p20">40. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 2" id="i.iii.ii-p20.1" parsed="|Matt|8|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.2">Matt. viii,
2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 12" id="i.iii.ii-p20.2" parsed="|Luke|5|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.12">Luke v, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p21">44. See thou say nothing to any man - But our blessed Lord
gives no such charge to us. If he has made us clean from our leprosy of
sin, we are not commanded to conceal it. On the contrary, it is our duty
to publish it abroad, both for the honour of our Benefactor, and that
others who are sick of sin may be encouraged to ask and hope for the
same benefit. But go, show thyself to the priest, and offer for thy
cleansing what Moses commanded for a testimony to them - The priests
seeing him, pronouncing him clean, <scripRef passage="Lev. xiii. 17, 23, 28, 37" id="i.iii.ii-p21.1" parsed="|Lev|13|17|0|0;|Lev|13|23|0|0;|Lev|13|28|0|0;|Lev|13|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.13.17 Bible:Lev.13.23 Bible:Lev.13.28 Bible:Lev.13.37">Lev. xiii, 17, 23, 28, 37</scripRef>, and accordingly allowing him to offer as Moses commanded, <scripRef passage="Lev. xiv. 2, 7" id="i.iii.ii-p21.2" parsed="|Lev|14|2|0|0;|Lev|14|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.14.2 Bible:Lev.14.7">Lev. xiv, 2, 7</scripRef>, was such a proof against them, that they durst never say
the leper was not cleansed; which out of envy or malice against our
saviour they might have been ready to say, upon his presenting himself
to be viewed, according to the law, if by the cleansed person's talking
much about his cure, the account of it had reached their ears before he
came in person. This is one great reason why our Lord commanded this man
to say nothing.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ii-p22">45. So that Jesus could no more openly enter into the city
- It was also to prevent this inconvenience that our Lord had enjoined
him silence.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="4.00%" prev="i.iii.ii" next="i.iii.iv" id="i.iii.iii">
<h3 id="i.iii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark II" id="i.iii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2" /> 

<p id="i.iii.iii-p1">1. And again - After having been in desert places for some
time, he returned privately to the city. In the house - In Peter's
house.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p2">2. And immediately many were gathered together - Hitherto
continued the general impression on their hearts. Hitherto, even at
Capernaum, all who heard received the word with joy.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p3">3. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 2" id="i.iii.iii-p3.1" parsed="|Matt|9|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.2">Matt. ix, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 18" id="i.iii.iii-p3.2" parsed="|Luke|5|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.18">Luke v, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p4">4. They uncovered the roof - Or, took up the covering, the
lattice or trap door, which was on all their houses, (being flat
roofed.) And finding it not wide enough, broke the passage wider, to let
down the couch.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p5">6. But certain of the scribes - See whence the first
offense cometh! As yet not one of the plain unlettered people were
offended. They all rejoiced in the light, till these men of learning
came, to put darkness for light, and light for darkness. Woe to all such
blind guides! Good had it been for these if they had never been born. O
God, let me never offend one of thy simple ones! Sooner let my tongue
cleave to the roof of my mouth!</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p6">12. They were all amazed - Even the scribes themselves for
a time.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p7">13. All the multitude came to him - Namely, by the sea
side. And he as readily taught them there as if they had been in a
synagogue.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p8">14. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 9" id="i.iii.iii-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|9|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.9">Matt. ix, 9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 27" id="i.iii.iii-p8.2" parsed="|Luke|5|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.27">Luke v, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p9">15. Many publicans and notorious sinners sat with Jesus -
Some of them doubtless invited by Matthew, moved with compassion for his
old companions in sin. But the next words, For there were many, and they
followed him, seem to imply, that the greater part, encouraged by his
gracious words and the tenderness of his behaviour, and impatient to
hear more, stayed for no invitation, but pressed in after him, and kept
as close to him as they could.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p10">16. And the scribes and Pharisees said - So now the wise
men being joined by the saints of the world, went a little further in
raising prejudices against our Lord. In his answer he uses as yet no
harshness, but only calm, dispassionate reasoning.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p11">17. I came not to call the righteous - Therefore if these
were righteous I should not call them. But now, they are the very
persons I came to save.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p12">18. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 14" id="i.iii.iii-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|9|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.14">Matt. ix,
14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke v. 33" id="i.iii.iii-p12.2" parsed="|Luke|5|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5.33">Luke v, 33</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p13">23. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 1" id="i.iii.iii-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.1">Matt. xii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 1" id="i.iii.iii-p13.2" parsed="|Luke|6|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.1">Luke vi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p14">26. In the days of Abiathar the high priest - Abimelech,
the father of Abiathar, was high priest then; Abiathar himself not till
some time after. This phrase therefore only means, In the time of
Abiathar, who was afterward the high priest. <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxi. 6" id="i.iii.iii-p14.1" parsed="|1Sam|21|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.21.6">1 Sam. xxi, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p15">27. The Sabbath was made for man - And therefore must give
way to man's necessity.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iii-p16">28. Moreover the Son of man is Lord even of the Sabbath -
Being the supreme Lawgiver, he hath power to dispense with his own laws;
and with this in particular.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="4.05%" prev="i.iii.iii" next="i.iii.v" id="i.iii.iv">
<h3 id="i.iii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark III" id="i.iii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3" /> 

<p id="i.iii.iv-p1">He entered again into the synagogue - At Capernaum on the
same day. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 9" id="i.iii.iv-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|12|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.9">Matt. xii, 9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 6" id="i.iii.iv-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|6|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.6">Luke vi, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p2">2. And they - The scribes and Pharisees, watched him, that
they might accuse him - Pride, anger, and shame, after being so often
put to silence, began now to ripen into malice.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p3">4. Is it lawful to save life or to kill? - Which he knew
they were seeking occasion to do. But they held their peace - Being
confounded, though not convinced.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p4">5. Looking round upon them with anger, being grieved -
Angry at the sin, grieved at the sinner; the true standard of Christian
anger. But who can separate anger at sin from anger at the sinner? None
but a true believer in Christ.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p5">6. The Pharisees going out - Probably leaving the scribes
to watch him still: took counsel with the Herodians - as bitter as they
usually were against each other.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p6">8. From Idumea - The natives of which had now professed the
Jewish religion above a hundred and fifty years. They about Tyre and
Sidon - The Israelites who lived in those coasts.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p7">10. Plagues or scourges (so the Greek word properly means)
seem to be those very painful or afflictive disorders which were
frequently sent, or at least permitted of God, as a scourge or
punishment of sin.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p8">12. He charged them not to make him known - It was not the
time: nor were they fit preachers.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p9">13. He calleth whom he would - With regard to the eternal
states of men, God always acts as just and merciful. But with regard to
numberless other things, he seems to us to act as a mere sovereign. <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 12" id="i.iii.iv-p9.1" parsed="|Luke|6|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.12">Luke vi, 12</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p10">14. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 2" id="i.iii.iv-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.2">Matt. x, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 13" id="i.iii.iv-p10.2" parsed="|Luke|6|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.13">Luke vi, 13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Acts i. 13" id="i.iii.iv-p10.3" parsed="|Acts|1|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1.13">Acts i, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p11">16. He surnamed them sons of thunder - Both with respect to
the warmth and impetuosity of their spirit, their fervent manner of
preaching, and the power of their word.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p12">20. To eat bread - That is, to take any subsistence.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p13">21. His relations - His mother and his brethren, ver. 31.
But it was some time before they could come near him.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p14">22. The scribes and Pharisees, <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 22" id="i.iii.iv-p14.1" parsed="|Matt|12|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.22">Matt. xii, 22</scripRef>; who had come down from Jerusalem - Purposely on the devil's
errand. And not without success. For the common people now began to
drink in the poison, from these learned, good, honourable men! He hath
Beelzebub - at command, is in league with him: And by the prince of the
devils casteth he out devils - How easily may a man of learning elude
the strongest proof of a work of God! How readily can he account for
every incident without ever taking God into the question. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 24" id="i.iii.iv-p14.2" parsed="|Matt|12|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.24">Matt.
xii, 24</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xi. 15" id="i.iii.iv-p14.3" parsed="|Luke|11|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.15">Luke xi,
15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p15">28. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 31" id="i.iii.iv-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|12|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.31">Matt. xii,
31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 10" id="i.iii.iv-p15.2" parsed="|Luke|12|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.10">Luke xii,
10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p16">30. Because they said, He hath an unclean spirit - Is it
not astonishing, that men who have ever read these words, should doubt,
what is the blasphemy against the Holy Ghost? Can any words declare more
plainly, that it is "the ascribing those miracles to the power of the
devil which Christ wrought by the power of the Holy Ghost?"</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p17">31. Then come his brethren and his mother - Having at
length made their way through the crowd, so as to come to the door. His
brethren are here named first, as being first and most earnest in the
design of taking him: for neither did these of his brethren believe on
him. They sent to him, calling him - They sent one into the house, who
called him aloud, by name. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 46" id="i.iii.iv-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|12|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.46">Matt. xii,
46</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 19" id="i.iii.iv-p17.2" parsed="|Luke|8|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.19">Luke viii, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.iv-p18">34. Looking round on them who sat about him - With the
utmost sweetness; He said, Behold my mother and my brethren -- in this
preference of his true disciples even to the Virgin Mary, considered
merely as his mother after the flesh, he not only shows his high and
tender affection for them, but seems designedly to guard against those
excessive and idolatrous honours, which he foresaw would in after ages
be paid to her.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="4.11%" prev="i.iii.iv" next="i.iii.vi" id="i.iii.v">
<h3 id="i.iii.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark IV" id="i.iii.v-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4" /> 

<p id="i.iii.v-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 1" id="i.iii.v-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|13|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.1">Matt. xiii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 4" id="i.iii.v-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|8|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.4">Luke viii,
4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p2">2. He taught them many things by parables - After the usual
manner of the eastern nations, to make his instructions more agreeable
to them, and to impress them the more upon attentive hearers. A parable
signifies not only a simile or comparison, and sometimes a proverb, but
any kind of instructive speech, wherein spiritual things are explained
and illustrated by natural, <scripRef passage="Prov. i. 6" id="i.iii.v-p2.1" parsed="|Prov|1|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.1.6">Prov. i,
6</scripRef>. To understand a proverb and the interpretation - The
proverb is the literal sense, the interpretation is the spiritual
resting in the literal sense killeth, but the spiritual giveth life.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p3">3. Hearken - This word he probably spoke with a loud voice,
to stop the noise and hurry of the people.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p4">10. When he was alone - That is, retired apart from the
multitude.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p5">11. To them that are without - So the Jews termed the
heathens: so our Lord terms all obstinate unbelievers: for they shall
not enter into his kingdom: they shall abide in outer darkness.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p6">12. So that seeing they see and do not perceive - They
would not see before now they could not, God having given them up to the
blindness which they had chosen.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p7">13. Know ye not this parable? - Which is as it were the
foundation of all those that I shall speak hereafter; and is so easy to
be understood?</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p8">19. The desire of other things choke the word - A deep and
important truth! The desire of any thing, otherwise than as it leads to
happiness in God, directly tends to barrenness of soul. Entering in -
Where they were not before. Let him therefore who has received and
retained the word, see that no other desire then enter in, such as
perhaps till then he never knew. It becometh unfruitful - After the
fruit had grown almost to perfection.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p9">21. And he said, Is a candle - As if he had said, I explain
these things to you, I give you this light, not to conceal, but to
impart it to others. And if I conceal any thing from you now, it is only
that it may be more effectually manifested hereafter. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 15" id="i.iii.v-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|5|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.15">Matt. v, 15</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 16; xi. 33" id="i.iii.v-p9.2" parsed="|Luke|8|16|0|0;|Luke|11|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.16 Bible:Luke.11.33">Luke viii, 16; xi, 33</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p10">22. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 26" id="i.iii.v-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|10|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.26">Matt. x, 26</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 17" id="i.iii.v-p10.2" parsed="|Luke|8|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.17">Luke viii, 17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p11">24. Take heed what ye hear - That is, attend to what you
hear, that it may have its due influence upon you. With what measure you
mete - That is, according to the improvement you make of what you have
heard, still further assistance shall be given. And to you that hear -
That is, with improvement.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p12">25. He that hath - That improves whatever he has received,
to the good of others, as well as of his own soul. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 12" id="i.iii.v-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|13|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.12">Matt. xiii, 12</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 18" id="i.iii.v-p12.2" parsed="|Luke|8|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.18">Luke viii, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p13">26. So is the kingdom of God - The inward kingdom is like
seed which a man casts into the ground - This a preacher of the Gospel
casts into the heart. And he sleeps and rises night and day - That is,
he has it continually in his thoughts. Meantime it springs and grows up
he knows not how - Even he that sowed it cannot explain how it grows.
For as the earth by a curious kind of mechanism, which the greatest
philosophers cannot comprehend, does as it were spontaneously bring
forth first the blade, then the ear, then the full corn in the ear: so
the soul, in an inexplicable manner, brings forth, first weak graces,
then stronger, then full holiness: and all this of itself, as a machine,
whose spring of motion is within itself. Yet observe the amazing
exactness of the comparison. The earth brings forth no corn (as the soul
no holiness) without both the care and toil of man, and the benign
influence of heaven.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p14">29. He putteth in the sickle - God cutteth down and
gathereth the corn into his garner.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p15">30. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 31" id="i.iii.v-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|13|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.31">Matt. xiii,
31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xiii. 18" id="i.iii.v-p15.2" parsed="|Luke|13|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13.18">Luke xiii,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p16">33. He spake the word as they were able to hear it -
Adapting it to the capacity of his hearers; and speaking as plain as he
could without offending them. A rule never to be forgotten by those who
instruct others.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p17">35. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 23" id="i.iii.v-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|8|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.23">Matt. viii,
23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 22" id="i.iii.v-p17.2" parsed="|Luke|8|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.22">Luke viii,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p18">36. They take him as he was in the vessel - They carried
him immediately in the same vessel from which he had been preaching to
the people.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p19">38. On the pillow - So we translate it, for want of a
proper English expression, for that particular part of the vessel near
the rudder, on which he lay.</p>

<p id="i.iii.v-p20">39. Peace - Cease thy tossing: Be still - Cease thy
roaring; literally, Be thou gagged.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="4.18%" prev="i.iii.v" next="i.iii.vii" id="i.iii.vi">
<h3 id="i.iii.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark V" id="i.iii.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.5" /> 

<p id="i.iii.vi-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 28" id="i.iii.vi-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|8|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.28">Matt. viii,
28</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 26" id="i.iii.vi-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|8|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.26">Luke viii,
26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p2">2. There met him a man with an unclean spirit - St. Matthew
mentions two. Probably this, so particularly spoken of here, was the
most remarkably fierce and ungovernable.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p3">9. My name is Legion! for we are many - But all these seem
to have been under one commander, who accordingly speaks all along, both
for them and himself.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p4">15. And they were afraid - It is not improbable they might
otherwise have offered some rudeness, if not violence.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p5">18. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 1" id="i.iii.vi-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|9|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.1">Matt. ix, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 37" id="i.iii.vi-p5.2" parsed="|Luke|8|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.37">Luke viii, 37</scripRef>;</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p6">19. Tell them how great things the Lord hath done for thee
- This was peculiarly needful there, where Christ did not go in
person.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p7">20. He published in Decapolis - Not only at home, but in
all that country where Jesus himself did not come.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p8">21. <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 40" id="i.iii.vi-p8.1" parsed="|Luke|8|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.40">Luke viii,
40</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p9">22. One of the rulers of the synagogue - To regulate the
affairs of every synagogue, there was a council of grave men. Over these
was a president, who was termed the ruler of the synagogue. Sometimes
there was no more than one ruler in a synagogue. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 18" id="i.iii.vi-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|9|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.18">Matt. ix, 18</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 41" id="i.iii.vi-p9.2" parsed="|Luke|8|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.41">Luke viii, 41</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p10">25. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 20" id="i.iii.vi-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|9|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.20">Matt. ix,
20</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 43" id="i.iii.vi-p10.2" parsed="|Luke|8|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.43">Luke viii,
43</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p11">37. John, the brother of James - When St. Mark wrote, not
long after our Lord's ascension, the memory of St. James, lately
beheaded, was so fresh, that his name was more known than that of John
himself.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p12">40. Them that were with him - Peter, James, and John.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vi-p13">43. He charged them that no man should know it - That he
might avoid every appearance of vain glory, might prevent too great a
concourse of people, and might not further enrage the scribes and
Pharisees against him; the time for his death, and for the full
manifestation of his glory, being not yet come. He commanded something
should be given her to eat - So that when either natural or spiritual
life is restored, even by immediate miracle, all proper means are to be
used in order to preserve it.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="4.22%" prev="i.iii.vi" next="i.iii.viii" id="i.iii.vii">
<h3 id="i.iii.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark VI" id="i.iii.vii-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6" /> 

<p id="i.iii.vii-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 54" id="i.iii.vii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|13|54|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.54">Matt. xiii,
54</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 16" id="i.iii.vii-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|4|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.16">Luke iv,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p2">3. Is not this the carpenter? - There can be no doubt, but
in his youth he wrought with his supposed father Joseph.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p3">5. He could do no miracle there - Not consistently with his
wisdom and goodness. It being inconsistent with his wisdom to work them
there, where it could not promote his great end; and with his goodness,
seeing he well knew his countrymen would reject whatever evidence could
be given them. And therefore to have given them more evidence, would
only have increased their damnation.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p4">6. He marvelled - As man. As he was God, nothing was
strange to him.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p5">7. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 1" id="i.iii.vii-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|10|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.1">Matt. x, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 1" id="i.iii.vii-p5.2" parsed="|Luke|9|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.1">Luke ix, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p6">8. He commanded them to take nothing for their journey -
That they might be always unincumbered, free, ready for motion. Save a
staff only - He that had one might take it; but he that had not was not
to provide one, <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 9" id="i.iii.vii-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|10|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.9">Matt. x, 9</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 3" id="i.iii.vii-p6.2" parsed="|Luke|9|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.3">Luke ix, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p7">9. Be shod with sandals - As you usually are. Sandals were
pieces of strong leather or wood, tied under the sole of the foot by
thongs, something resembling modern clogs. The shoes which they are in
St. Matthew forbidden to take, were a kind of short boots, reaching a
little above the mid-leg, which were then commonly used in journeys. Our
Lord intended by this mission to initiate them into their apostolic
work. And it was doubtless an encouragement to them all their life
after, to recollect the care which God took of them, when they had left
all they had, and went out quite unfurnished for such an expedition. In
this view our Lord himself leads them to consider it, Luke xxii, xxxv,
When I sent you forth without purse or scrip, lacked ye any thing?</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p8">10. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 11" id="i.iii.vii-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|10|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.11">Matt. x, 11</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 4" id="i.iii.vii-p8.2" parsed="|Luke|9|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.4">Luke ix, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p9">12. <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 6" id="i.iii.vii-p9.1" parsed="|Luke|9|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.6">Luke ix,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p10">13. They anointed with oil many that were sick - Which St.
James gives as a general direction, <scripRef passage="James v. 14, 15" id="i.iii.vii-p10.1" parsed="|Jas|5|14|5|15" osisRef="Bible:Jas.5.14-Jas.5.15">James v, 14, 15</scripRef>, adding those peremptory words, And the Lord shall heal him
- He shall be restored to health: not by the natural efficacy of the
oil, but by the supernatural blessing of God. And it seems this was the
great standing means of healing, desperate diseases in the Christian
Church, long before extreme unction was used or heard of, which bears
scarce any resemblance to it; the former being used only as a means of
health; the latter only when life is despaired of.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p11">14. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 1" id="i.iii.vii-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.1">Matt. xiv,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 7" id="i.iii.vii-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|9|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.7">Luke ix, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p12">15. A prophet, as one of the prophets - Not inferior to one
of the ancient prophets.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p13">16. But Herod hearing thereof - Of their various judgments
concerning him, still said, It is John.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p14">20. And preserved him - Against all the malice and
contrivances of Herodias. And when he heard him - Probably sending for
him, at times, during his imprisonment, which continued a year and a
half. He heard him gladly - Delusive joy! While Herodias lay in his
bosom.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p15">21. A convenient day - Convenient for her purpose. His
lords, captains, and principal men of Galilee - The great men of the
court, the army, and the province.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p16">23. To the half of my kingdom - A proverbial
expression.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p17">26. Yet for his oath's sake, and for the sake of his guests
- Herod's honour was like the conscience of the chief priests, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 6" id="i.iii.vii-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|27|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.6">Matt. xxvii, 6</scripRef>. To shed innocent blood wounded neither one nor the
other.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p18">30. <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 10" id="i.iii.vii-p18.1" parsed="|Luke|9|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.10">Luke ix,
10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p19">31. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 13" id="i.iii.vii-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|14|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.13">Matt. xiv,
13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John vi. 1" id="i.iii.vii-p19.2" parsed="|John|6|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.6.1">John vi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p20">32. They departed - Across a creek or corner of the
lake.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p21">34. Coming out - of the vessel.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p22">40. They sat down in ranks - The word properly signifies a
parterre or bed in a garden; by a metaphor, a company of men ranged in
order, by hundreds and by fifties - That is, fifty in rank, and a
hundred in file. So a hundred multiplied by fifty, make just five
thousand.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p23">43. Full of the fragments - of the bread.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p24">45. He constrained his disciples - Who did not care to go
without him. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 22" id="i.iii.vii-p24.1" parsed="|Matt|14|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.22">Matt. xiv,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p25">46. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 23" id="i.iii.vii-p25.1" parsed="|Matt|14|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.23">Matt. xiv,
23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John vi. 15" id="i.iii.vii-p25.2" parsed="|John|6|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.6.15">John vi,
15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p26">48. And he saw them - For the darkness could veil nothing
from him. And would have passed by them - That is, walked, as if he was
passing by.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p27">52. Their heart was hardened - And yet they were not
reprobates. It means only, they were slow and dull of apprehension.</p>

<p id="i.iii.vii-p28">53. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 34" id="i.iii.vii-p28.1" parsed="|Matt|14|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.34">Matt. xiv,
34</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John vi. 21" id="i.iii.vii-p28.2" parsed="|John|6|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.6.21">John vi,
21</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="4.29%" prev="i.iii.vii" next="i.iii.ix" id="i.iii.viii">
<h3 id="i.iii.viii-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark VII" id="i.iii.viii-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.7" /> 

<p id="i.iii.viii-p1">1. Coming from Jerusalem - Probably on purpose to find
occasion against him. <scripRef passage="Matt. xv. 1" id="i.iii.viii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|15|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.15.1">Matt. xv,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p2">4. Washing of cups and pots and brazen vessels and couches
- The Greek word (baptisms) means indifferently either washing or
sprinkling. The cups, pots, and vessels were washed; the couches
sprinkled.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p3">5. The tradition of the elders - The rule delivered down
from your forefathers.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p4">6. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxix. 13" id="i.iii.viii-p4.1" parsed="|Isa|29|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.29.13">Isaiah xxix,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p5">10. <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 12" id="i.iii.viii-p5.1" parsed="|Exod|20|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.12">Exod. xx,
12</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Exod. xxi. 17" id="i.iii.viii-p5.2" parsed="|Exod|21|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.21.17">Exod. xxi,
17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p6">15. There is nothing entering into a man from without which
can defile him - Though it is very true, a man may bring guilt, which is
moral defilement, upon himself by eating what hurts his health, or by
excess either in meat or drink yet even here the pollution arises from
the wickedness of the heart, and is just proportionable to it. And this
is all that our Lord asserts.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p7">19. Purging all meats - Probably the seat was usually
placed over running water.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p8">22. Wickedness - The word means ill natured, cruelty,
inhumanity, and all malevolent affections. Foolishness - Directly
contrary to sobriety of thought and discourse: all kind of wild
imaginations and extravagant passions.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p9">24. <scripRef passage="Matt. xv. 21" id="i.iii.viii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|15|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.15.21">Matt. xv,
21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p10">26. The woman was a Greek (that is, a Gentile, not a Jew) a
Syrophenician or Canaanite. Canaan was also called Syrophenicia, as
lying between Syria, properly so called, and Phenicia.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p11">31. <scripRef passage="Matt. xv. 29" id="i.iii.viii-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|15|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.15.29">Matt. xv,
29</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p12">33. He put his fingers into his ears - Perhaps intending to
teach us, that we are not to prescribe to him (as they who brought this
man attempted to do) but to expect his blessing by whatsoever means he
pleases: even though there should be no proportion or resemblance
between the means used, and the benefit to be conveyed thereby.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p13">34. Ephphatha - This was a word of SOVEREIGN AUTHORITY, not
an address to God for power to heal: such an address was needless; for
Christ had a perpetual fund of power residing in himself, to work all
miracles whenever he pleased, even to the raising the dead, <scripRef passage="John v. 21, 26" id="i.iii.viii-p13.1" parsed="|John|5|21|0|0;|John|5|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.5.21 Bible:John.5.26">John v, 21, 26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.viii-p14">36. Them - The blind man and those that brought him.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="4.32%" prev="i.iii.viii" next="i.iii.x" id="i.iii.ix">
<h3 id="i.iii.ix-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark VIII" id="i.iii.ix-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8" /> 

<p id="i.iii.ix-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xv. 32" id="i.iii.ix-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|15|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.15.32">Matt. xv,
32</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p2">8. So they did eat - This miracle was intended to
demonstrate, that Christ was the true bread which cometh down from
heaven; for he who was almighty to create bread without means to support
natural life, could not want power to create bread without means to
support spiritual life. And this heavenly bread we stand so much in need
of every moment, that we ought to be always praying, Lord, evermore give
us this bread.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p3">11. Tempting him - That is, trying to ensnare him. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 1" id="i.iii.ix-p3.1" parsed="|Matt|16|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.1">Matt. xvi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p4">12. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 4" id="i.iii.ix-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|16|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.4">Matt. xvi,
4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p5">15. Beware of the leaven of the Pharisees and of Herod, or
of the Sadducees; two opposite extremes.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p6">17, 18. Our Lord here affirms of all the apostles, (for the
question is equivalent to an affirmation, ) That their hearts were
hardened; that having eyes they saw not, having ears they heard not;
that they did not consider, neither understand: the very same
expressions that occur in the thirteenth of Matthew. And yet it is
certain they were not judicially hardened. Therefore all these strong
expressions do not necessarily import any thing more than the present
want of spiritual understanding.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p7">23. He led him out of the town - It was in just displeasure
against the inhabitants of Bethsaida for their obstinate infidelity,
that our Lord would work no more miracles among them, nor even suffer
the person he had cured, either to go into the town, or to tell it to
any therein.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p8">24. I see men as trees walking - He distinguished men from
trees only by their motion.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p9">27. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 13" id="i.iii.ix-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|16|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.13">Matt. xvi,
13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 18" id="i.iii.ix-p9.2" parsed="|Luke|9|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.18">Luke ix,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p10">30. He enjoined them silence for the present,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iii.ix-p11">1. That he might not encourage the people to
set him up for a temporal king;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iii.ix-p12">2. That he might not provoke the scribes and
Pharisees to destroy him before the time and,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iii.ix-p13">3. That he might not forestall the bright
evidence which was to be given of his Divine character after his
resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p14">31. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 21" id="i.iii.ix-p14.1" parsed="|Matt|16|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.21">Matt. xvi,
21</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 22" id="i.iii.ix-p14.2" parsed="|Luke|9|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.22">Luke ix,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p15">32. He spake that saying openly - Or in express terms. Till
now he had only intimated it to them. And Peter taking hold of him -
Perhaps by the arms or clothes.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p16">33. Looking on his disciples - That they might the more
observe what he said to Peter.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p17">34. And when he called the people - To hear a truth of the
last importance, and one that equally concerned them all. Let him deny
himself - His own will, in all things small and great, however pleasing,
and that continually: And take up his cross - Embrace the will of God,
however painful, daily, hourly, continually. Thus only can he follow me
in holiness to glory.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p18">35. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 25" id="i.iii.ix-p18.1" parsed="|Matt|16|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.25">Matt. xvi,
25</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 24" id="i.iii.ix-p18.2" parsed="|Luke|9|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.24">Luke ix, 24</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xvii. 33" id="i.iii.ix-p18.3" parsed="|Luke|17|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17.33">Luke xvii, 33</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xii. 25" id="i.iii.ix-p18.4" parsed="|John|12|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.25">John xii, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.ix-p19">38. Whosoever shall be ashamed of me and of my words - That
is, avowing whatever I have said (particularly of self denial and the
daily cross) both by word and action. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 32" id="i.iii.ix-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|10|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.32">Matt. x, 32</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 26" id="i.iii.ix-p19.2" parsed="|Luke|9|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.26">Luke ix, 26</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 8" id="i.iii.ix-p19.3" parsed="|Luke|12|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.8">Luke xii, 8</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="4.37%" prev="i.iii.ix" next="i.iii.xi" id="i.iii.x">
<h3 id="i.iii.x-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark IX" id="i.iii.x-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9" /> 

<p id="i.iii.x-p1">1. Till they see the kingdom of God coming with power - So
it began to do at the day of pentecost, when three thousand were
converted to God at once.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p2">2. By themselves - That is, separate from the multitude:
Apart - From the other apostles: and was transfigured - The Greek word
seems to refer to the form of God, and the form of a servant, {mentioned
by St. Paul, <scripRef passage="Phil. ii. 6, 7" id="i.iii.x-p2.1" parsed="|Phil|2|6|2|7" osisRef="Bible:Phil.2.6-Phil.2.7">Phil. ii, 6,
7</scripRef>} and may intimate, that the Divine rays, which the
indwelling God let out on this occasion, made the glorious change from
one of these forms into the other. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 1" id="i.iii.x-p2.2" parsed="|Matt|17|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.1">Matt. xvii, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 28" id="i.iii.x-p2.3" parsed="|Luke|9|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.28">Luke ix, 28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p3">3. White as snow, such as no fuller can whiten - Such as
could not be equalled either by nature or art.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p4">4. Elijah - Whom they expected: Moses, whom they did
not.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p5">7. There came a (bright, luminous) cloud, overshadowing
them - This seems to have been such a cloud of glory as accompanied
Israel in the wilderness, which, as the Jewish writers observe, departed
at the death of Moses. But it now appeared again, in honour of our Lord,
as the great Prophet of the Church, who was prefigured by Moses. Hear ye
him - Even preferably to Moses and Elijah.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p6">12. Elijah verily coming first restoreth all things: and
how it is written - That is, And he told them how it is written - As if
he had said, Elijah's coming is not inconsistent with my suffering. He
is come: yet I shall suffer. The first part of the verse answers their
question concerning Elijah; the second refutes their error concerning
the Messiah's continuing forever.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p7">14. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 14" id="i.iii.x-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|17|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.14">Matt. xvii,
14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 37" id="i.iii.x-p7.2" parsed="|Luke|9|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.37">Luke ix,
37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p8">15. All the multitude seeing him were greatly amazed - At
his coming so suddenly, so seasonably, so unexpectedly: perhaps also at
some unusual rays of majesty and glory, which yet remained on his
countenance.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p9">17. And one of the multitude answering - The scribes gave
no answer to our Lord's question. They did not care to repeat what they
had said to his disciples. A dumb spirit - A spirit that takes his
speech from him.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p10">20. When he saw him - When the child saw Christ; when his
deliverance was at hand. Immediately the spirit tore him - Made his last
grand effort to destroy him. Is it not generally so, before Satan is
cast out of a soul, of which he has long had possession?</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p11">22. If thou canst do any thing - In so desperate a case:
Have compassion on us - Me as well as him.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p12">23. If thou canst believe - As if he had said, The thing
does not turn on my power, but on thy faith. I can do all things: canst
thou believe?</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p13">24. Help thou mine unbelief - Although my faith be so
small, that it might rather be termed unbelief, yet help me.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p14">25. Thou deaf and dumb spirit - So termed, because he made
the child so. When Jesus spake, the devil heard, though the child could
not. I command thee - I myself now; not my disciples.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p15">26. Having rent him sore - So does even the body sometimes
suffer, when God comes to deliver the soul from Satan.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p16">30. They passed through Galilee - Though not through the
cities, but by them, in the most private ways. He was not willing that
any should know it: for he taught his disciples - He wanted to be alone
with them some time, in order to instruct them fully concerning his
sufferings. The Son of man is delivered - It is as sure as if it were
done already. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 22" id="i.iii.x-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|17|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.22">Matt. xvii,
22</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 44" id="i.iii.x-p16.2" parsed="|Luke|9|44|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.44">Luke ix,
44</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p17">32. They understood not the word - They did not understand
how to reconcile the death of our saviour (nor consequently his
resurrection, which supposed his death) with their notions of his
temporal kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p18">33. <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 46" id="i.iii.x-p18.1" parsed="|Luke|9|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.46">Luke ix,
46</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p19">34. Who should be greatest - Prime minister in his
kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p20">35. Let him be the least of all - Let him abase himself the
most.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p21">36. <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 2" id="i.iii.x-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|18|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.2">Matt. xviii,
2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 47" id="i.iii.x-p21.2" parsed="|Luke|9|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.47">Luke ix,
47</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p22">37. One such little child - Either in years or in
heart.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p23">38. And John answered him - As if he had said, But ought we
to receive those who follow not us? Master, we saw one casting out
devils in thy name - Probably this was one of John the Baptist's
disciples, who believed in Jesus, though he did not yet associate with
our Lord's disciples. And we forbad him, because he followeth not us -
How often is the same temper found in us? How readily do we also lust to
envy? But how does that spirit become a disciple, much more a minister
of the benevolent Jesus! St. Paul had learnt a better temper, when he
rejoiced that Christ was preached, even by those who were his personal
enemies. But to confine religion to them that follow us, is a narrowness
of spirit which we should avoid and abhor. <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 49" id="i.iii.x-p23.1" parsed="|Luke|9|49|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.49">Luke ix, 49</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p24">39. Jesus said - Christ here gives us a lovely example of
candour and moderation. He was willing to put the best construction on
doubtful cases, and to treat as friends those who were not avowed
enemies. Perhaps in this instance it was a means of conquering the
remainder of prejudice, and perfecting what was wanting in the faith and
obedience of these persons. Forbid him not - Neither directly nor
indirectly discourage or hinder any man who brings sinners from the
power of Satan to God, because he followeth not us, in opinions, modes
of worship, or any thing else which does not affect the essence of
religion.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p25">40. For he that is not against you, is for you - Our Lord
had formerly said, he that is not with me, is against me: thereby
admonishing his hearers, that the war between him and Satan admitted of
no neutrality, and that those who were indifferent to him now, would
finally be treated as enemies. But here in another view, he uses a very
different proverb; directing his followers to judge of men's characters
in the most candid manner; and charitably to hope that those who did not
oppose his cause wished well to it. Upon the whole, we are to be
rigorous in judging ourselves, and candid in judging each other.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p26">41. For whosoever shall give you a cup - Having answered
St. John, our Lord here resumes the discourse which was broken off at
the 37th verse. <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 37" id="i.iii.x-p26.1" parsed="|Mark|9|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.37">Mark ix, 37</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 42" id="i.iii.x-p26.2" parsed="|Matt|10|42|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.42">Matt. x, 42</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p27">42. On the contrary, whosoever shall offend the very least
Christian. <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 6" id="i.iii.x-p27.1" parsed="|Matt|18|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.6">Matt. xviii, 6</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xvii. 1" id="i.iii.x-p27.2" parsed="|Luke|17|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17.1">Luke xvii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p28">43. And if a person cause thee to offend - (The discourse
passes from the case of offending, to that of being offended) if one who
is as useful or dear to thee as a hand or eye, hinder or slacken thee in
the ways of God, renounce all intercourse with him. This primarily
relates to persons, secondarily to things. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 29" id="i.iii.x-p28.1" parsed="|Matt|5|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.29">Matt. v, 29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 8" id="i.iii.x-p28.2" parsed="|Matt|18|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.8">Matt. xviii, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p29">44. Where their worm - That gnaweth the soul, (pride, self
will, desire, malice, envy, shame, sorrow, despair) dieth not - No
more than the soul itself: and the fire (either material, or infinitely
worse!) that tormenteth the body, is not quenched forever. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxvi. 24" id="i.iii.x-p29.1" parsed="|Isa|66|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.66.24">Isaiah lxvi, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p30">49. Everyone - Who does not cut off the offending member,
and consequently is cast into hell, shall be, as it were, salted with
fire, preserved, not consumed thereby whereas every acceptable sacrifice
shall be salted with another kind of salt, even that of Divine grace,
which purifies the soul, (though frequently with pain) and preserves it
from corruption.</p>

<p id="i.iii.x-p31">50. Such salt is good indeed; highly beneficial to the
world, in respect of which I have termed you the salt of the earth. But
if the salt which should season others, have lost its own saltness,
wherewith will ye season it? - Beware of this; see that ye retain your
savour; and as a proof of it, have peace one with another. More largely
this obscure text might be paraphrased thus:- As every burnt offering
was salted with salt, in order to its being cast into the fire of the
altar, so every one who will not part with his hand or eye, shall fall a
sacrifice to Divine justice, and be cast into hell fire, which will not
consume, but preserve him from a cessation of being. And on the other
hand, every one, who, denying himself and taking up his cross, offers up
himself as a living sacrifice to God, shall be seasoned with grace,
which like salt will make him savoury, and preserve him from destruction
forever. As salt is good for preserving meats, and making them savoury,
so it is good that ye be seasoned with grace, for the purifying your
hearts and lives, and for spreading the savour of my knowledge, both in
your own souls, and wherever ye go. But as salt if it loses its saltness
is fit for nothing, so ye, if ye lose your faith and love, are fit for
nothing but to be utterly destroyed. See therefore that grace abide in
you, and that ye no more contend, Who shall be greatest. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 13" id="i.iii.x-p31.1" parsed="|Matt|5|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.13">Matt. v, 13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xiv. 34" id="i.iii.x-p31.2" parsed="|Luke|14|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.14.34">Luke xiv, 34</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="4.52%" prev="i.iii.x" next="i.iii.xii" id="i.iii.xi">
<h3 id="i.iii.xi-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark X" id="i.iii.xi-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10" /> 

<p id="i.iii.xi-p1">1. He cometh thence - From Galilee. <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 1" id="i.iii.xi-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|19|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.1">Matt. xix, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p2">2. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 31" id="i.iii.xi-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|5|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.31">Matt. v, 31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 7" id="i.iii.xi-p2.2" parsed="|Matt|19|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.7">Matt. xix, 7</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xvi. 18" id="i.iii.xi-p2.3" parsed="|Luke|16|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.16.18">Luke xvi, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p3">4. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxiv. 1" id="i.iii.xi-p3.1" parsed="|Deut|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.24.1">Deut. xxiv,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p4">6. From the beginning of the creation - Therefore Moses in
the first of Genesis gives us an account of things from the beginning of
the creation. Does it not clearly follow, that there was no creation
previous to that which Moses describes? God made them male and female -
Therefore Adam did not at first contain both sexes in himself: but God
made Adam, when first created, male only; and Eve female only. And this
man and woman he joined together, in a state of innocence, as husband
and wife.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p5">7. <scripRef passage="Gen. ii. 24" id="i.iii.xi-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|2|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.2.24">Gen. ii,
24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p6">11, 12. All polygamy is here totally condemned.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p7">13. <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 13" id="i.iii.xi-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|19|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.13">Matt. xix,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p8">14. Jesus seeing it was much displeased - At their blaming
those who were not blame worthy: and endeavouring to hinder the children
from receiving a blessing. Of such is the kingdom of God - The members
of the kingdom which I am come to set up in the world are such as these,
as well as grown persons, of a child-like temper.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p9">15. Whosoever shall not receive the kingdom of God as a
little child - As totally disclaiming all worthiness and fitness, as if
he were but a week old.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p10">17. <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 16" id="i.iii.xi-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|19|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.16">Matt. xix,
16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xviii. 18" id="i.iii.xi-p10.2" parsed="|Luke|18|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.18.18">Luke xviii,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p11">20. He answering, said to him, Master - He stands reproved
now, and drops the epithet good.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p12">21. Jesus looking upon him - And looking into his heart,
loved him - Doubtless for the dawnings of good which he saw in him: and
said to him - Out of tender love, One thing thou lackest - The love of
God, without which all religion is a dead carcass. In order to this,
throw away what is to thee the grand hindrance of it. Give up thy great
idol, riches. Go, sell whatsoever thou hast.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p13">24. Jesus saith to them, Children - See how he softens the
harsh truth, by the manner of delivering it! And yet without retracting
or abating one tittle: How hard is it for them that trust in riches -
Either for defense, or happiness, or deliverance from the thousand
dangers that life is continually exposed to. That these cannot enter
into God's glorious kingdom, is clear and undeniable: but it is easier
for a camel to go through a needle's eye, than for a man to have riches,
and not trust in them. Therefore, it is easier for a camel to go through
the eye of a needle, than for a rich man to enter the kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p14">28. Lo, we have left all - Though the young man would
not.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p15">30. He shall receive a hundred fold, houses, etc. - Not
in the same kind: for it will generally be with persecutions: but in
value: a hundred fold more happiness than any or all of these did or
could afford. But let it be observed, none is entitled to this
happiness, but he that will accept it with persecutions.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p16">32. They were in the way to Jerusalem, and Jesus went
before them: and they were amazed - At his courage and intrepidity,
considering the treatment which he had himself told them he should meet
with there: and as they followed, they were afraid - Both for him and
themselves: nevertheless he judged it best to prepare them, by telling
them more particularly what was to ensue. <scripRef passage="Matt. xx. 17" id="i.iii.xi-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|20|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.17">Matt. xx, 17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xviii. 31" id="i.iii.xi-p16.2" parsed="|Luke|18|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.18.31">Luke xviii, 31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p17">35. Saying - By their mother. It was she, not they that
uttered the words. <scripRef passage="Matt. xx. 20" id="i.iii.xi-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|20|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.20">Matt. xx,
20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p18">38. Ye know not what ye ask - Ye know not that ye ask for
sufferings, which must needs pave the way to glory. The cup - Of inward;
the baptism - Of outward sufferings. Our Lord was filled with sufferings
within, and covered with them without.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p19">40. Save to them for whom it is prepared - Them who by
patient continuance in well doing, seek for glory, and honour, and
immortality. For these only eternal life is prepared. To these, only he
will give it in that day; and to every man his own reward, according to
his own labour.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p20">45. A ransom for many - Even for as many souls as needed
such a ransom, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. v. 15" id="i.iii.xi-p20.1" parsed="|2Cor|5|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.5.15">2 Cor. v,
15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p21">46. <scripRef passage="Matt. xx. 29" id="i.iii.xi-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|20|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.29">Matt. xx,
29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xviii. 35" id="i.iii.xi-p21.2" parsed="|Luke|18|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.18.35">Luke xviii,
35</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xi-p22">50. Casting away his garment - Through joy and
eagerness.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="4.59%" prev="i.iii.xi" next="i.iii.xiii" id="i.iii.xii">
<h3 id="i.iii.xii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark XI" id="i.iii.xii-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11" /> 

<p id="i.iii.xii-p1">1. To Bethphage and Bethany, at the Mount of Olives - The
limits of Bethany reached to the Mount of Olives, and joined to those of
Bethphage. Bethphage was part of the suburbs of Jerusalem, and reached
from the Mount of Olives to the walls of the city. Our Lord was now come
to the place where the boundaries of Bethany and Bethphage met. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 1" id="i.iii.xii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|21|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.1">Matt. xxi, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 29" id="i.iii.xii-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|19|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.29">Luke xix, 29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xii. 12" id="i.iii.xii-p1.3" parsed="|John|12|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.12">John xii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p2">11. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 10, 17" id="i.iii.xii-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|21|10|0|0;|Matt|21|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.10 Bible:Matt.21.17">Matt. xxi, 10,
17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p3">12. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 18" id="i.iii.xii-p3.1" parsed="|Matt|21|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.18">Matt. xxi,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p4">13. For it was not a season of figs - It was net (as we
say) a good year for figs; at least not for that early sort, which alone
was ripe so soon in the spring. If we render the words, It was not the
season of figs, that is, the time of gathering them in, it may mean, The
season was not yet: and so (inclosing the words in a parenthesis, And
coming to it, he found nothing but leaves) it may refer to the former
part of the sentence, and may be considered as the reason of Christ's
going to see whether there were any figs on this tree. Some who also
read that clause in a parenthesis, translate the following words, for
where he was, it was the season of figs. And it is certain, this meaning
of the words suits best with the great design of the parable, which was
to reprove the Jewish Church for its unfruitfulness at that very season,
when fruit might best be expected from them.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p5">15. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 12" id="i.iii.xii-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|21|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.12">Matt. xxi,
12</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 45" id="i.iii.xii-p5.2" parsed="|Luke|19|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.45">Luke xix,
45</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p6">16. He suffered not that any should carry a vessel through
the temple - So strong notions had our Lord, of even relative holiness!
And of the regard due to those places (as well as times) that are
peculiarly dedicated to God.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p7">17. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lvi. 7" id="i.iii.xii-p7.1" parsed="|Isa|56|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.56.7">Isaiah lvi,
7</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Jer. vii. 11" id="i.iii.xii-p7.2" parsed="|Jer|7|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.7.11">Jer. vii,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p8">18. They feared him - That is, they were afraid to take him
by violence, lest it should raise a tumult; because all the people were
astonished at his teaching - Both at the excellence of his discourse,
and at the majesty and authority with which he taught.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p9">20. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 20" id="i.iii.xii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|21|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.20">Matt. xxi,
20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p10">22. Have faith in God - And who could find fault, if the
Creator and Proprietor of all things were to destroy, by a single word
of his mouth, a thousand of his inanimate creatures, were it only to
imprint this important lesson more deeply on one immortal spirit?</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p11">25. When ye stand praying - Standing was their usual
posture when they prayed. Forgive - And on this condition, ye shall have
whatever you ask, without wrath or doubting. <scripRef passage="Matt. vi. 14" id="i.iii.xii-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|6|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.6.14">Matt. vi, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xii-p12">27. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 23" id="i.iii.xii-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|21|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.23">Matt. xxi,
23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 1" id="i.iii.xii-p12.2" parsed="|Luke|20|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.1">Luke xx, 1</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="4.63%" prev="i.iii.xii" next="i.iii.xiv" id="i.iii.xiii">
<h3 id="i.iii.xiii-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark XII" id="i.iii.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12" /> 

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 43" id="i.iii.xiii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|21|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.43">Matt. xxi,
43</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 9" id="i.iii.xiii-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|20|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.9">Luke xx, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p2">10. <scripRef passage="Psalm cxviii. 22" id="i.iii.xiii-p2.1" parsed="|Ps|118|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.118.22">Psalm cxviii,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p3">12. They feared the multitude - How wonderful is the
providence of God, using all things for the good of his children!
Generally the multitude is restrained from tearing them in pieces only
by the fear of their rulers. And here the rulers themselves are
restrained, through fear of the multitude!</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p4">13. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxii. 15" id="i.iii.xiii-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|22|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.22.15">Matt. xxii,
15</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 20" id="i.iii.xiii-p4.2" parsed="|Luke|20|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.20">Luke xx,
20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p5">17. They marvelled at him - At the wisdom of his
answer.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p6">18. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 23" id="i.iii.xiii-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|21|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.23">Matt. xxi,
23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 27" id="i.iii.xiii-p6.2" parsed="|Luke|20|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.27">Luke xx,
27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p7">19. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 5" id="i.iii.xiii-p7.1" parsed="|Deut|25|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.5">Deut. xxv,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p8">25. When they rise from the dead, neither men marry nor
women are given in marriage.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p9">26. <scripRef passage="Exod. iii. 6" id="i.iii.xiii-p9.1" parsed="|Exod|3|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3.6">Exod. iii,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p10">27. He is not the God of the dead, but the God of the
living - That is, (if the argument be proposed at length, ) since the
character of his being the God of any persons, plainly intimates a
relation to them, not as dead, but as living; and since he cannot be
said to be at present their God at all, if they are utterly dead; nor to
be the God of human persons, such as Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob,
consisting of souls and bodies, if their bodies were to abide in
everlasting death; there must needs be a future state of blessedness,
and a resurrection of the body to share with the soul in it.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p11">28. Which is the first commandment? - The principal, and
most necessary to be observed. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxii. 34" id="i.iii.xiii-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|22|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.22.34">Matt.
xxii, 34</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke x. 25" id="i.iii.xiii-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|10|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.25">Luke x,
25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p12">29. The Lord our God is one Lord - This is the foundation
of the first commandment, yea, of all the commandments. The Lord our
God, the Lord, the God of all men, is one God, essentially, though three
persons. From this unity of God it follows, that we owe all our love to
him alone. <scripRef passage="Deut. vi. 4" id="i.iii.xiii-p12.1" parsed="|Deut|6|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.6.4">Deut. vi, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p13">30. With all thy strength - That is, the whole strength and
capacity of thy understanding, will, and affections.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p14">31. The second is like unto it - Of a like comprehensive
nature: comprising our whole duty to man. There is no other moral, much
less ceremonial commandment, greater than these. <scripRef passage="Lev. xix. 18" id="i.iii.xiii-p14.1" parsed="|Lev|19|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.18">Lev. xix, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p15">33. To love him with all the heart - To love and serve him,
with all the united powers of the soul in their utmost vigour; and to
love his neighbour as himself - To maintain the same equitable and
charitable temper and behaviour toward all men, as we, in like
circumstances, would wish for from them toward ourselves, is a more
necessary and important duty, than the offering the most noble and
costly sacrifices.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p16">34. Jesus said to him, Thou art not far from the kingdom of
God - Reader, art not thou? then go on: be a real Christian: else it had
been better for thee to have been afar off.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p17">35. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxii. 41" id="i.iii.xiii-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|22|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.22.41">Matt. xxii,
41</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 41" id="i.iii.xiii-p17.2" parsed="|Luke|20|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.41">Luke xx,
41</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p18">36. <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 1" id="i.iii.xiii-p18.1" parsed="|Ps|110|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.1">Psalm cx,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p19">38. Beware of the scribes - There was an absolute necessity
for these repeated cautions. For, considering their inveterate
prejudices against Christ, it could never be supposed the common people
would receive the Gospel till these incorrigible blasphemers of it were
brought to just disgrace. Yet he delayed speaking in this manner till a
little before his passion, as knowing what effect it would quickly
produce. Nor is this any precedent for us: we are not invested with the
same authority. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 5" id="i.iii.xiii-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|23|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.5">Matt. xxiii,
5</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xx. 46" id="i.iii.xiii-p19.2" parsed="|Luke|20|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20.46">Luke xx,
46</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p20">41. He beheld how people cast money into the treasury -
This treasury received the voluntary contributions of the worshippers
who came up to the feast; which were given to buy wood for the altar,
and other necessaries not provided for in any other way. <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 1" id="i.iii.xiii-p20.1" parsed="|Luke|21|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.1">Luke xxi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiii-p21">43. I say to you, that this poor widow hath cast in more
than they all - See what judgement is cast on the most specious, outward
actions by the Judge of all! And how acceptable to him is the smallest,
which springs from self-denying love!</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="4.69%" prev="i.iii.xiii" next="i.iii.xv" id="i.iii.xiv">
<h3 id="i.iii.xiv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark XIII" id="i.iii.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13" /> 

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 1" id="i.iii.xiv-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.1">Matt. xxiv,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 5" id="i.iii.xiv-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|21|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.5">Luke xxi,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p2">4. Two questions are here asked; the one concerning the
destruction of Jerusalem: the other concerning the end of the world.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p3">9. <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 12" id="i.iii.xiv-p3.1" parsed="|Luke|21|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.12">Luke xxi,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p4">10. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 14" id="i.iii.xiv-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|24|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.14">Matt. xxiv,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p5">11. The Holy Ghost will help you. But do not depend upon
any other help For all the nearest ties will be broken.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p6">14. Where it ought not - That place being set apart for
sacred use. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 15" id="i.iii.xiv-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|24|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.15">Matt. xxiv,
15</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 20" id="i.iii.xiv-p6.2" parsed="|Luke|21|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.20">Luke xxi, 20</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Dan. ix. 27" id="i.iii.xiv-p6.3" parsed="|Dan|9|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.9.27">Dan. ix, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p7">19. In those days shall be affliction, such as was not from
the beginning of the creation - May it not be doubted, whether this be
yet fully accomplished? Is not much of this affliction still to
come?</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p8">20. The elect - The Christians: whom he hath chosen - That
is, hath taken out of, or separated from, the world, through
sanctification of the Spirit and belief of the truth. He hath shortened
- That is, will surely shorten.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p9">21. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 23" id="i.iii.xiv-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|24|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.23">Matt. xxiv,
23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p10">24. But in those days - Which immediately precede the end
of the world: after that tribulation - Above described.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p11">28. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 32" id="i.iii.xiv-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|24|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.32">Matt. xxiv,
32</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 28" id="i.iii.xiv-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|21|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.28">Luke xxi,
28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p12">29. He is nigh - The Son of man.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p13">30. All these things - Relating to the temple and the
city.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p14">32. Of that day - The day of judgment is often in the
Scriptures emphatically called that day. Neither the Son - Not as man:
as man he was no more omniscient than omnipresent. But as God he knows
all the circumstances of it.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p15">33. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 42" id="i.iii.xiv-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|24|42|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.42">Matt. xxiv,
42</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 34" id="i.iii.xiv-p15.2" parsed="|Luke|21|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.34">Luke xxi,
34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xiv-p16">34. The Son of man is as a man taking a far journey - Being
about to leave this world and go to the Father, he appoints the services
that are to be performed by all his servants, in their several stations.
This seems chiefly to respect ministers at the day of judgment: but it
may be applied to all men, and to the time of death. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxv. 14" id="i.iii.xiv-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|25|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.25.14">Matt. xxv, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 12" id="i.iii.xiv-p16.2" parsed="|Luke|19|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.12">Luke xix, 12</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="4.72%" prev="i.iii.xiv" next="i.iii.xvi" id="i.iii.xv">
<h3 id="i.iii.xv-p0.1">XIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark XIV" id="i.iii.xv-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14" /> 

<p id="i.iii.xv-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 1" id="i.iii.xv-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|26|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.1">Matt. xxvi,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 1" id="i.iii.xv-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|22|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.1">Luke xxii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p2">3. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 6" id="i.iii.xv-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|26|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.6">Matt. xxvi,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p3">4. Some had indignation - Being incited thereto by Judas:
and said - Probably to the women.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p4">10. Judas went to the chief priests - Immediately after
this reproof, having anger now added to his covetousness. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 14" id="i.iii.xv-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|26|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.14">Matt. xxvi, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 3" id="i.iii.xv-p4.2" parsed="|Luke|22|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.3">Luke xxii, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p5">12. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 17" id="i.iii.xv-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|26|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.17">Matt. xxvi,
17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 7" id="i.iii.xv-p5.2" parsed="|Luke|22|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.7">Luke xxii,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p6">13. Go into the city, and there shall meet you a man - It
was highly seasonable for our Lord to give them this additional proof
both of his knowing all things, and of his influence over the minds of
men.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p7">15. Furnished - The word properly means, spread with
carpets.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p8">17. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 20" id="i.iii.xv-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|26|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.20">Matt. xxvi,
20</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 14" id="i.iii.xv-p8.2" parsed="|Luke|22|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.14">Luke xxii,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p9">24. This is my blood of the New Testament - That is, this I
appoint to be a perpetual sign and memorial of my blood, as shed for
establishing the new covenant, that all who shall believe in me may
receive all its gracious promises.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p10">25. I will drink no more of the fruit of the vine, till I
drink it new in the kingdom of God - That is, I shall drink no more
before I die: the next wine I drink will not be earthly, but
heavenly.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p11">26. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 30" id="i.iii.xv-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|26|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.30">Matt. xxvi,
30</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 39" id="i.iii.xv-p11.2" parsed="|Luke|22|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.39">Luke xxii,
39</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 1" id="i.iii.xv-p11.3" parsed="|John|18|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.1">John xviii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p12">27. This night - The Jews in reckoning their days began
with the evening, according to the Mosaic computation, which called the
evening and the morning the first day, <scripRef passage="Gen. i. 5" id="i.iii.xv-p12.1" parsed="|Gen|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.1.5">Gen. i, 5</scripRef>. And so that which after sunset is here called this night
is, ver. 30, called today. The expression there is peculiarly
significant. Verily I say to thee, that thou thyself, confident as thou
art, today, even within four and twenty hours; yea, this night, or ever
the sun be risen, nay, before the cock crow twice, before three in the
morning, wilt deny me thrice. Our Lord doubtless spoke so determinately,
as knowing a cock would crow once before the usual time of cock crowing.
By chap. xiii, 35, it appears, that the third watch of the night, ending
at three in the morning, was commonly styled the cock crowing. <scripRef passage="Zech. xiii. 7" id="i.iii.xv-p12.2" parsed="|Zech|13|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.13.7">Zech. xiii, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p13">32. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 36" id="i.iii.xv-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|26|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.36">Matt. xxvi,
36</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p14">33. Sore amazed - The original word imports the most
shocking amazement, mingled with grief: and that word in the next verse
which we render sorrowful intimates, that he was surrounded with sorrow
on every side, breaking in upon him with such violence, as was ready to
separate his soul from his body.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p15">36. Abba, Father - St. Mark seems to add the word Father,
by way of explication.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p16">37. Saith to Peter - The zealous, the confident Peter.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p17">43. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 47" id="i.iii.xv-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|26|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.47">Matt. xxvi,
47</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 47" id="i.iii.xv-p17.2" parsed="|Luke|22|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.47">Luke xxii,
47</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 2" id="i.iii.xv-p17.3" parsed="|John|18|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.2">John xviii,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p18">44. Whomsoever I shall kiss - Probably our Lord, in great
condescension, had used (according to the Jewish custom) to permit his
disciples to do this, after they had been some time absent.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p19">47. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 51" id="i.iii.xv-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|26|51|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.51">Matt. xxvi,
51</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 49" id="i.iii.xv-p19.2" parsed="|Luke|22|49|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.49">Luke xxii,
49</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 10" id="i.iii.xv-p19.3" parsed="|John|18|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.10">John xviii,
10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p20">51. A young man - It does not appear, that he was one of
Christ's disciples. Probably hearing an unusual noise, he started up out
of his bed, not far from the garden, and ran out with only the sheet
about him, to see what was the matter. And the young men laid hold on
him - Who was only suspected to be Christ's disciple: but could not
touch them who really were so.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p21">53. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 57" id="i.iii.xv-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|26|57|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.57">Matt. xxvi,
57</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 54" id="i.iii.xv-p21.2" parsed="|Luke|22|54|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.54">Luke xxii,
54</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 12" id="i.iii.xv-p21.3" parsed="|John|18|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.12">John xviii,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p22">55. All the council sought for witness and found none -
What an amazing proof of the overruling providence of God, considering
both their authority, and the rewards they could offer, that no two
consistent witnesses could be procured, to charge him with any gross
crime. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 59" id="i.iii.xv-p22.1" parsed="|Matt|26|59|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.59">Matt. xxvi, 59</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p23">56. Their evidences were not sufficient - The Greek words
literally rendered are, Were not equal: not equal to the charge of a
capital crime: it is the same word in the 59th verse.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p24">58. We heard him say - It is observable, that the words
which they thus misrepresented, were spoken by Christ at least three
years before, <scripRef passage="John ii. 19" id="i.iii.xv-p24.1" parsed="|John|2|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.2.19">John ii, 19</scripRef>. Their going back so far to find matter for the charge, was
a glorious, though silent attestation of the unexceptionable manner
wherein he had behaved, through the whole course of his public
ministry.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p25">61. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 63" id="i.iii.xv-p25.1" parsed="|Matt|26|63|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.63">Matt. xxvi,
63</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 67" id="i.iii.xv-p25.2" parsed="|Luke|22|67|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.67">Luke xxii,
67</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p26">66. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 69" id="i.iii.xv-p26.1" parsed="|Matt|26|69|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.69">Matt. xxvi,
69</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 56" id="i.iii.xv-p26.2" parsed="|Luke|22|56|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.56">Luke xxii,
56</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 25" id="i.iii.xv-p26.3" parsed="|John|18|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.25">John xviii,
25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xv-p27">72. And he covered his head - Which was a usual custom with
mourners, and was fitly expressive both of grief and shame.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="4.80%" prev="i.iii.xv" next="i.iii.xvii" id="i.iii.xvi">
<h3 id="i.iii.xvi-p0.1">XV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark XV" id="i.iii.xvi-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15" /> 

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 1, 2" id="i.iii.xvi-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|27|1|27|2" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.1-Matt.27.2">Matt. xxvii, 1,
2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 66" id="i.iii.xvi-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|22|66|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.66">Luke xxii,
66</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 1" id="i.iii.xvi-p1.3" parsed="|Luke|23|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.1">Luke xxiii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 28" id="i.iii.xvi-p1.4" parsed="|John|18|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.28">John xviii,
28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p2">3. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 12" id="i.iii.xvi-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|27|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.12">Matt. xxvii,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p3">7. Insurrection - A crime which the Roman governors, and
Pilate in particular, were more especially concerned and careful to
punish.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p4">9. Will ye that I release to you the king of the Jews -
Which does this wretched man discover most? Want of justice, or courage,
or common sense? The poor coward sacrifices justice to popular clamour,
and enrages those whom he seeks to appease, by so unseasonably repeating
that title, The king of the Jews, which he could not but know was so
highly offensive to them.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p5">16. Praetorium - The inner hall, where the praetor, a Roman
magistrate, used to give judgment. But St. John calls the whole palace
by this name. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 27" id="i.iii.xvi-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|27|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.27">Matt. xxvii,
27</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 2" id="i.iii.xvi-p5.2" parsed="|John|19|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.2">John xix,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p6">17. Purple - As royal robes were usually purple and
scarlet, St. Mark and John term this a purple robe, St. Matthew a
scarlet one. The Tyrian purple is said not to have been very different
from scarlet.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p7">20. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 31" id="i.iii.xvi-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|27|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.31">Matt. xxvii,
31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 16" id="i.iii.xvi-p7.2" parsed="|John|19|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.16">John xix,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p8">21. The father of Alexander and Rufus - These were
afterward two eminent Christians, and must have been well known when St.
Mark wrote.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p9">22. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 33" id="i.iii.xvi-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|27|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.33">Matt. xxvii,
33</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 33" id="i.iii.xvi-p9.2" parsed="|Luke|23|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.33">Luke xxiii,
33</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 17" id="i.iii.xvi-p9.3" parsed="|John|19|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.17">John xix,
17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p10">24, 25. St. Mark seems to intimate, that they first nailed
him to the cross, then parted his garments, and afterward reared up the
cross.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p11">28. <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 12" id="i.iii.xvi-p11.1" parsed="|Isa|53|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.12">Isaiah liii,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p12">29. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 39" id="i.iii.xvi-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|27|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.39">Matt. xxvii,
39</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p13">33. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 45" id="i.iii.xvi-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|27|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.45">Matt. xxvii,
45</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 44" id="i.iii.xvi-p13.2" parsed="|Luke|23|44|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.44">Luke xxiii,
44</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p14">34. My God, my God, why hast thou forsaken me - Thereby
claiming God as his God; and yet lamenting his Father's withdrawing the
tokens of his love, and treating him as an enemy, while he bare our
sins.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p15">37. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 50" id="i.iii.xvi-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|27|50|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.50">Matt. xxvii,
50</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 46" id="i.iii.xvi-p15.2" parsed="|Luke|23|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.46">Luke xxiii,
46</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 30" id="i.iii.xvi-p15.3" parsed="|John|19|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.30">John xix,
30</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p16">41. Who served him - Provided him with necessaries.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p17">42. Because it was the day before the Sabbath - And the
bodies might not hang on the Sabbath day: therefore they were in haste
to have them taken down.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p18">43. honourable - A man of character and reputation: A
counsellor - A member of the sanhedrim. Who waited for the kingdom of
God - Who expected to see it set up on earth. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 57" id="i.iii.xvi-p18.1" parsed="|Matt|27|57|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.57">Matt. xxvii, 57</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 50" id="i.iii.xvi-p18.2" parsed="|Luke|23|50|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.50">Luke xxiii, 50</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 38" id="i.iii.xvi-p18.3" parsed="|John|19|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.38">John xix, 38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvi-p19">46. He rolled a stone - By his servants. It was too large
for him to roll himself.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="4.83%" prev="i.iii.xvi" next="i.iv" id="i.iii.xvii">
<h3 id="i.iii.xvii-p0.1">XVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Mark XVI" id="i.iii.xvii-p0.2" parsed="|Mark|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.16" /> 

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxviii. 1" id="i.iii.xvii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|28|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.28.1">Matt. xxviii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 1" id="i.iii.xvii-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.1">Luke xxiv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xx. 1" id="i.iii.xvii-p1.3" parsed="|John|20|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.1">John xx, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p2">2. At the rising of the sun - They set out while it was yet
dark, and came within sight of the sepulchre, for the first time, just
as it grew light enough to discern that the stone was rolled away, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxviii. 1" id="i.iii.xvii-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|28|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.28.1">Matt. xxviii, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 1" id="i.iii.xvii-p2.2" parsed="|Luke|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.1">Luke xxiv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xx. 1" id="i.iii.xvii-p2.3" parsed="|John|20|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.1">John xx, 1</scripRef>. But by the time Mary had called Peter and John, and they
had viewed the sepulchre, the sun was rising.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p3">3. Who shall roll us away the stone - This seems to have
been the only difficulty they apprehended. So they knew nothing of
Pilate's having sealed the stone, and placed a guard of soldiers
there.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p4">7. And Peter - Though he so oft denied his Lord. What
amazing goodness was this!</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p5">9. <scripRef passage="John xx. 11" id="i.iii.xvii-p5.1" parsed="|John|20|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.11">John xx,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p6">10. <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 9" id="i.iii.xvii-p6.1" parsed="|Luke|24|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.9">Luke xxiv,
9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xx. 18" id="i.iii.xvii-p6.2" parsed="|John|20|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.18">John xx,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p7">12. <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 13" id="i.iii.xvii-p7.1" parsed="|Luke|24|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.13">Luke xxiv,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p8">13. Neither believed they them - They were moved a little
by the testimony of these, added to that of St. Peter, <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 34" id="i.iii.xvii-p8.1" parsed="|Luke|24|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.34">Luke xxiv, 34</scripRef>; but they did not yet fully believe it.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p9">14. <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 36" id="i.iii.xvii-p9.1" parsed="|Luke|24|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.36">Luke xxiv,
36</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xx. 19" id="i.iii.xvii-p9.2" parsed="|John|20|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.19">John xx,
19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p10">15. Go ye into all the world, and preach the Gospel to
every creature - Our Lord speaks without any limitation or restriction.
If therefore every creature in every age hath not heard it, either those
who should have preached, or those who should have heard it, or both,
made void the counsel of God herein. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxviii. 19" id="i.iii.xvii-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|28|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.28.19">Matt. xxviii, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p11">16. And is baptized - In token thereof. Everyone that
believed was baptized. But he that believeth not - Whether baptized or
unbaptized, shall perish everlastingly.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p12">17. And these signs shall follow them that believe - An
eminent author sub-joins, "That believe with that very faith mentioned
in the preceding verse." (Though it is certain that a man may work
miracles, and not have saving faith, <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 22, 23" id="i.iii.xvii-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|7|22|7|23" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.22-Matt.7.23">Matt. vii, 22, 23</scripRef>.) "It was not one faith by which St. Paul was saved, another
by which he wrought miracles. Even at this day in every believer faith
has a latent miraculous power; (every effect of prayer being really
miraculous;) although in many, both because of their own littleness of
faith, and because the world is unworthy, that power is not exerted.
Miracles, in the beginning, were helps to faith; now also they are the
object of it. At Leonberg, in the memory of our fathers, a cripple that
could hardly move with crutches, while the dean was preaching on this
very text, was in a moment made whole." Shall follow - The word and
faith must go before. In my name - By my authority committed to them.
Raising the dead is not mentioned. So our Lord performed even more than
he promised.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p13">18. If they drink any deadly thing - But not by their own
choice. God never calls us to try any such experiments.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p14">19. The Lord - How seasonable is he called by this title!
After he had spoken to them - For forty days. <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 50" id="i.iii.xvii-p14.1" parsed="|Luke|24|50|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.50">Luke xxiv, 50</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iii.xvii-p15">20. They preached everywhere - At the time St. Mark wrote,
the apostles had already gone into all the known world, <scripRef passage="Rom. x. 18" id="i.iii.xvii-p15.1" parsed="|Rom|10|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.10.18">Rom. x, 18</scripRef>; and each of them was there known where he preached: the
name of Christ only was known throughout the world.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE GOSPEL ACCORDING TO ST. LUKE" progress="4.89%" prev="i.iii.xvii" next="i.iv.i" id="i.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke" id="i.iv-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.iv-p0.2">NOTES ON THE GOSPEL ACCORDING TO ST. LUKE</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Luke" progress="4.89%" prev="i.iv" next="i.iv.ii" id="i.iv.i">

<p id="i.iv.i-p1">HEREIN WE MAY OBSERVE,</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.iv.i-p2">I. The beginning: and therein.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iv.i-p3">1. The conception of John Chap. i, 5-25</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iv.i-p4">2. The conception of Christ 26-56</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iv.i-p5">3. The birth and circumcision of John; the
hymn of Zacharias; the youth of <scripRef passage="John 57" id="i.iv.i-p5.1" parsed="|John|57|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.57">John 57</scripRef>-80</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iv.i-p6">4. Christ's birth ii, 1-20 Christ's
circumcision and name 21 Presentation in the temple 22-38 Country and
growth 39, 40</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.iv.i-p7">II. The middle, when he was twelve years old
and upward 41-52</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.iv.i-p8">III. The course of the history.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iv.i-p9">A. The introduction, wherein are described
John the Baptist; Christ's baptism, and temptation iii, iv, 1-13</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iv.i-p10">B. The acceptable year in Galilee,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p11">a. Proposed at Nazareth 14-30</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p12">b. Actually exhibited,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p13">I. At Capernaum and near it; here we may
observe,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p14">1. Actions not censured, while Jesus</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p15">1. Teaches with authority 31, 32</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p16">2. Casts out a devil 33-37</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p17">3. Heals many sick 38-41</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p18">4. Teaches everywhere 42-44</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p19">5. Calls Peter; then James and John Chap. v,
1-11</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p20">6. Cleanses the leper 12-16</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p21">2. Actions censured, more and more severally,
here occur,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p22">1. The healing the paralytic 17-26</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p23">2. The calling of Levi; eating with publicans
and sinners. 27-32</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p24">3. The question concerning fasting 33-39</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p25">4. The plucking the ears of corn vi, 1-5</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p26">5. The withered hand restored; snares laid
6-11</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p27">3. Actions having various effects on various
persons,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p28">1. Upon the apostles 12-16</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p29">2. Upon other hearers 17-40</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p30">3. Upon the centurion vii, 1-10</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p31">4. Upon the disciples of John,</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iv.i-p32">The occasion: the young man raised 11-17</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iv.i-p33">The message and answer 18-23</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.iv.i-p34">The reproof of them that believed not <scripRef passage="John 24" id="i.iv.i-p34.1" parsed="|John|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.24">John
24</scripRef>-35</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p35">5. Upon Simon and the penitent sinner
36-50</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p36">6. Upon the woman who ministered to him viii,
1-3</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p37">7. Upon the people 4-18 Upon his mother and
brethren 19-21</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p38">II. On the sea, and 22-26 Beyond it 27-39</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p39">III. On this side again.</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p40">1. Jairus and the flux of blood 40-55</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p41">2. The apostles sent ix, 1-6</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p42">3. Herod's doubting 7-9</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p43">4. The relation of the apostles 10</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p44">5. The earnestness of the people; our Lord's
benignity; five thousand fed 11-17</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iv.i-p45">C. The preparation for his passion,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p46">a. A recapitulation of the doctrine
concerning his person: his passion foretold 18-27</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p47">b. His transfiguration; the lunatic healed;
his passion again foretold; humility enjoined 28-50</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p48">c. His last journey to Jerusalem, which we
may divide into eighteen intervals,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p49">1. The inhospitable Samaritans born with
51-57</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p50">2. In the way, improper followers repelled,
Proper ones pressed forward 58-62</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p51">3. Afterward the seventy sent; and received
again x, 1-24</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p52">And the scribe taught to love his neighbour,
by the example of the good Samaritan 25-37</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p53">4. In Bethany, Mary preferred before Martha
38-42</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p54">5. In a certain place the disciples taught to
pray xi, 1-13</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p55">A devil cast out, and the action defended
14-26</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p56">The acclamation of the woman corrected 27,
28</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p57">Those who desire a sign reproved 29-36</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p58">6. In a certain house, the scribes and
Pharisees censured. 37-54</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p59">7. Our Lord's discourse to his disciples xii,
1-12</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p60">To one that interrupts him 13-21</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p61">To his disciples again 22-40</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p62">To Peter 41-53</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p63">To the people 54-59</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p64">8. The necessity of repentance shown xiii,
1-9</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p65">A woman healed on the Sabbath 10-21</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p66">9. The fewness of them that are saved
22-30</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p67">10. Herod termed a fox: Jerusalem reproved
31-35</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p68">11. In the Pharisee's house, he cures the
dropsy on the</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p69">Sabbath; and xiv, 1-6</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p70">Teaches humility 7-11</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p71">Hoseapitality 12-14</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p72">The nature of the great supper 15-24</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p73">The necessity of self denial 25-35</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p74">12. Joy over repenting sinners defended, and
xv, 1-10</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p75">Illustrated by the story of the prodigal son
11-32</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p76">The unjust steward, wise in his generation
xvi, 1-13</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p77">The Pharisees reproved; and warned by the
story of 14-18 the rich</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p78">man and Lazarus 19-31</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p79">Cautions against scandals xvii, 1-4</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p80">The faith of the apostles increased 5-10</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p81">13. In the confines of Samaria and Galilee he
heals ten lepers. 11- 19</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p82">14. Answers the question concerning the time
when the kingdom of God should come 20-37</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p83">Commends constant prayer xviii, 1-8</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p84">Recommends humility by the story of the
Pharisee and publican 9-14</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p85">15. Blesses little children 15-17</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p86">Answers the rich young man 18-27</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p87">And Peter, asking what he should have
28-30</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p88">16. Foretells his passion a third time
31-34</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p89">17. Near Jericho, cures a blind man 35-42</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p90">18. In Jericho, brings salvation to Zacchaeus
xix, 1-10 Answers touching the sudden appearance of his kingdom.
11-28</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.iv.i-p91">D. Transactions at Jerusalem,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p92">a. The four first days of the great week,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p93">1. His royal entry 29-44</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p94">2. The abuse of the temple corrected 45,
46</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p95">Its use restored, and 47, 48</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p96">Vindicated xx, 1-8</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p97">3. His discourses in the temple,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p98">1. The parable of the husbandmen 9-19</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p99">2. The answer concerning paying tribute
20-26</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p100">And the resurrection 27-40</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p101">3. The question concerning the Son of David
41-44</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p102">4. The disciples admonished 45-47</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p103">5. The poor widow's offering commended xxi,
1-4</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p104">4. His prediction of the end of the temple,
the city, and the world 5-38</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p105">5. Judas's agreement with the chief priests
xxii, 1-6</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p106">b. Thursday,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p107">1. Peter and John prepare the passover
7-13</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p108">2. The Lord's Supper: discourse after it
14-23</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p109">3. The dispute, which of them was greatest
24-30</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p110">4. Peter, and the other apostles warned
31-38</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p111">5. On the Mount of Olives,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p112">1. Jesus prays; is in an agony; strengthened
by an angel; wakes his disciples 39-46</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p113">2. Is betrayed; unseasonably defended
47-53</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p114">3. Carried to the high priest's house 54</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p115">Denied by Peter 55-62</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p116">Mocked 63-65</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p117">c. Friday,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p118">1. His passion and death: transactions,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p119">1. In the council 66-71</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p120">2. With Pilate xxiii, 1-5</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p121">3. With Herod 6-12</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p122">4. With Pilate again 13-25</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p123">5. In the way 26-32</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.iv.i-p124">6. At Golgotha, where,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p125">The crucifixion itself, and Jesus's prayer
33, 34</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p126">His garments parted 34</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p127">Scoffs: the inscription on the cross
35-39</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p128">The penitent thief 40-43</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p129">The prodigies, and the death of Jesus
44-46</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.iv.i-p130">The beholders of it 47-49</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p131">2. His burial 50-53</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p132">d. Friday evening and Saturday 54-56</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p133">e. His resurrection made known,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p134">1. To the women Chap. xxiv, 1-12</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p135">2. To the two going into the country, and to
Peter 13-35</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.iv.i-p136">3. To the other apostles 36-45</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.i-p137">f. The instructions given his apostles: his
ascension 46-53</p>
<h2 id="i.iv.i-p137.1">THE GOSPEL OF LUKE</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="4.99%" prev="i.iv.i" next="i.iv.iii" id="i.iv.ii">
<h3 id="i.iv.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke I" id="i.iv.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1" /> 

<p id="i.iv.ii-p1">1, 2. This short, weighty, artless, candid dedication,
belongs to the Acts, as well as the Gospel of St. Luke. Many have
undertaken - He does not mean St. Matthew or Mark; and St. John did not
write so early. For these were eye witnesses themselves and ministers of
the word.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p2">3. To write in order - St. Luke describes in order of time;
first, The Acts of Christ; his conception, birth, childhood, baptism,
miracles, preaching, passion, resurrection, ascension: then, The Acts of
the Apostles. But in many smaller circumstances he does not observe the
order of time. Most excellent Theophilus - This was the appellation
usually given to Roman governors. Theophilus (as the ancients inform us)
was a person of eminent quality at Alexandria. In <scripRef passage="Acts i. 1" id="i.iv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Acts|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1.1">Acts i, 1</scripRef>, St. Luke does not give him that title. He was then probably
a private man. After the preface St. Luke gives us the history of
Christ, from his coming into the world to his ascension into heaven.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p3">5. The course of Abia - The priests were divided into
twenty-four courses, of which that of Abia was the eighth, <scripRef passage="1 Ch. xxiv. 10" id="i.iv.ii-p3.1" parsed="|1Chr|24|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.24.10">1 Ch xxiv, 10</scripRef>. Each course ministered in its turn, for seven days, from
Sabbath to Sabbath. And each priest of the course or set in waiting, had
his part in the temple service assigned him by lot.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p4">6. Walking in all the moral commandments, and ceremonial
ordinances, blameless - How admirable a character! May our behaviour be
thus unblamable, and our obedience thus sincere and universal!</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p5">10. The people were praying without, at the time of the
incense - So the pious Jews constantly did. And this was the foundation
of that elegant figure, by which prayer is in Scripture so often
compared to incense. Perhaps one reason of ordaining incense might be,
to intimate the acceptableness of the prayer that accompanied it; as
well as to remind the worshippers of that sacrifice of a sweet-smelling
savour, which was once to be offered to God for them, and of that
incense, which is continually offered with the prayers of the saints,
upon the golden altar that is before the throne, <scripRef passage="Rev. viii. 3, 4" id="i.iv.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Rev|8|3|8|4" osisRef="Bible:Rev.8.3-Rev.8.4">Rev. viii, 3, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p6">12. Zacharias was troubled - Although he was accustomed to
converse with God, yet we see he was thrown into a great consternation,
at the appearance of his angelical messenger, nature not being able to
sustain the sight. Is it not then an instance of the goodness is well as
of the wisdom of God, that the services, which these heavenly spirits
render us, are generally invisible?</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p7">13. Thy prayer is heard - Let us observe with pleasure,
that the prayers of pious worshippers come up with acceptance before
God; to whom no costly perfume is so sweet, as the fragrancy of an
upright heart. An answer of peace was here returned, when the case
seemed to be most helpless. Let us wait patiently for the Lord, and
leave to his own wisdom the time and manner wherein he will appear for
us. Thou shalt call his name John - John signifies the grace or favour
of Jehovah. A name well suiting the person, who was afterward so highly
in favour with God, and endued with abundance of grace; and who opened a
way to the most glorious dispensation of grace in the Messiah's kingdom.
And so Zacharias's former prayers for a child, and the prayer which he,
as the representative of the people, was probably offering at this very
time, for the appearing of the Messiah, were remarkably answered in the
birth of his forerunner.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p8">15. He shall be great before the Lord - God the Father: of
the Holy Ghost and the Son of God mention is made immediately after. And
shall drink neither wine nor strong drink - Shall be exemplary for
abstemiousness and self-denial; and so much the more filled with the
Holy Ghost.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p9">16. And many of the children of Israel shall he turn - None
therefore need be ashamed of "preaching like John the Baptist." To the
Lord their God - To Christ.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p10">17. He shall go before him, Christ, in the power and spirit
of Elijah - With the same integrity, courage, austerity, and fervour,
and the same power attending his word: to turn the hearts of the fathers
to the children - To reconcile those that are at variance, to put an end
to the most bitter quarrels, such as are very frequently those between
the nearest relations: and the hearts of the disobedient to the wisdom
of the just - And the most obstinate sinners to true wisdom, which is
only found among them that are righteous before God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p11">18. Zacharias said, Whereby shall I know this? - In how
different a spirit did the blessed virgin say, How shall this be?
Zacharias disbelieved the fact: Mary had no doubt of the thing; but only
inquired concerning the manner of it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p12">19. I am Gabriel, that stand in the presence of God - Seven
angels thus stand before God, <scripRef passage="Rev. vii. 2" id="i.iv.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Rev|7|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.7.2">Rev. vii,
2</scripRef>; who seem the highest of all. There seems to be a remarkable
gradation in the words, enhancing the guilt of Zacharias's unbelief. As
if he had said, I am Gabriel, a holy angel of God: yea, one of the
highest order. Not only so, but am now peculiarly sent from God; and
that with a message to thee in particular. Nay, and to show thee glad
tidings, such as ought to be received with the greatest joy and
readiness.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p13">20. Thou shalt be dumb - The Greek word signifies deaf, as
well as dumb: and it seems plain, that he was as unable to hear, as he
was to speak; for his friends were obliged to make signs to him, that he
might understand them, ver. 62.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p14">21. The people were waiting - For him to come and dismiss
them (as usual) with the blessing.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p15">24. Hid herself - She retired from company, that she might
have the more leisure to rejoice and bless God for his wonderful
mercy.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p16">25. He looked upon me to take away my reproach - Barrenness
was a great reproach among the Jews. Because fruitfulness was promised
to the righteous.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p17">26. In the sixth month - After Elisabeth had conceived.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p18">27. Espoused - It was customary among the Jews, for persons
that married to contract before witnesses some time before. And as
Christ was to be born of a pure virgin, so the wisdom of God ordered it
to be of one espoused, that to prevent reproach he might have a reputed
father, according to the flesh.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p19">28. Hail, thou highly favoured; the Lord is with thee;
blessed art thou among women - Hail is the salutation used by our Lord
to the women after his resurrection: thou art highly favoured, or hast
found favour with God, ver. 30, is no more than was said of Noah, Moses,
and David. The Lord is with thee, was said to Gideon, <scripRef passage="Judg. vi. 12" id="i.iv.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Judg|6|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.6.12">Judg. vi, 12</scripRef>; and blessed shall she be above women, of Jael, <scripRef passage="Judg. v. 24" id="i.iv.ii-p19.2" parsed="|Judg|5|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.5.24">Judg. v, 24</scripRef>. This salutation gives no room for any pretense of paying
adoration to the virgin; as having no appearance of a prayer, or of
worship offered to her.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p20">32. He shall be called the Son of the Highest - In this
respect also: and that in a more eminent sense than any, either man or
angel, can be called so. The Lord shall give him the throne of his
father David - That is, the spiritual kingdom, of which David's was a
type.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p21">33. He shall reign over the house of Jacob - In which all
true believers are included.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p22">35. The Holy Ghost shall come upon thee, and the power of
the Highest shall overshadow thee - The power of God was put forth by
the Holy Ghost, as the immediate Divine agent in this work: and so he
exerted the power of the Highest as his own power, who together with the
Father and the Son is the most high God. Therefore also - Not only as he
is God from eternity, but on this account likewise he shall be called
the Son of God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p23">36. And behold, thy cousin Elisabeth - Though Elisabeth was
of the house of Aaron, and Mary of the house of David, by the fathers
side, they might be related by their mothers. For the law only forbad
heiresses marrying into another tribe. And so other persons continually
intermarried; particularly the families of David and of Levi.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p24">38. And Mary said, Behold the handmaid of the Lord - It is
not improbable, that this time of the virgin's humble faith, consent,
and expectation, might be the very time of her conceiving.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p25">39. A city of Judah - Probably Hebron, which was situated
in the hill country of Judea, and belonged to the house of Aaron.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p26">41. When Elisabeth heard the salutation of Mary - The
discourse with which she saluted her, giving an account of what the
angel had said, the joy of her soul so affected her body, that the very
child in her womb was moved in an uncommon manner, as if it leaped for
joy.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p27">45. Happy is she that believed - Probably she had in her
mind the unbelief of Zacharias.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p28">46. And Mary said - Under a prophetic impulse, several
things, which perhaps she herself did not then fully understand.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p29">47. My spirit hath rejoiced in God my saviour - She seems
to turn her thoughts here to Christ himself, who was to be born of her,
as the angel had told her, he should be the Son of the Highest, whose
name should be Jesus, the saviour. And she rejoiced in hope of salvation
through faith in him, which is a blessing common to all true believers,
more than in being his mother after the flesh, which was an honour
peculiar to her. And certainly she had the same reason to rejoice in God
her saviour hat we have: because he had regarded the low estate of his
handmaid, in like manner as he regarded our low estate; and vouchsafed
to come and save her and us, when we were reduced to the lowest estate
of sin and misery.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p30">51. He hath wrought strength with his arm - That is, he
hath shown the exceeding greatness of his power. She speaks
prophetically of those things as already done, which God was about to do
by the Messiah. He hath scattered the proud - Visible and invisible.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p31">52. He hath put down the mighty - Both angels and men.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p32">54. He hath helped his servant Israel - By sending the
Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p33">55. To his seed - His spiritual seed: all true
believers.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p34">56. Mary returned to her own house - And thence soon after
to Bethlehem.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p35">60. His mother said - Doubtless by Revelation, or a
particular impulse from God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p36">66. The hand of the Lord - The peculiar power and blessing
of God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p37">67. And Zacharias prophesied - Of things immediately to
follow. But it is observable, he speaks of Christ chiefly; of John only,
as it were, incidentally.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p38">69. A horn - Signifies honour, plenty, and strength. A horn
of salvation - That is, a glorious and mighty saviour.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p39">70. His prophets, who have been since the world began - For
there were prophets from the very beginning.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p40">74. To serve him without fear - Without any slavish fear.
Here is the substance of the great promise. That we shall be always
holy, always happy: that being delivered from Satan and sin, from every
uneasy and unholy temper, we shall joyfully love and serve God, in every
thought, word, and work.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p41">76. And thou, child - He now speaks to John; yet not as a
parent, but as a prophet.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p42">77. To give knowledge of salvation by the remission of sins
- The knowledge of the remission of our sins being the grand instrument
of present and eternal salvation, <scripRef passage="Heb. viii. 11, 12" id="i.iv.ii-p42.1" parsed="|Heb|8|11|8|12" osisRef="Bible:Heb.8.11-Heb.8.12">Heb. viii, 11, 12</scripRef>. But the immediate sense of the words seems to be, to preach
to them the Gospel doctrine of salvation by the remission of their
sins.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ii-p43">78. The day spring - Or the rising sun; that is,
Christ.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="5.19%" prev="i.iv.ii" next="i.iv.iv" id="i.iv.iii">
<h3 id="i.iv.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke II" id="i.iv.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.2" /> 

<p id="i.iv.iii-p1">1. That all the world should be enrolled - That all the
inhabitants, male and female, of every town in the Roman empire, with
their families and estates, should be registered.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p2">2. When Cyrenius was governor of Syria - When Publius
Sulpicius Quirinus governed the province of Syria, in which Judea was
then included.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p3">6. And while they were there, the days were fulfilled that
she should be delivered - Mary seems not to have known that the child
must have been born in Bethlehem, agreeably to the prophecy. But the
providence of God took care for it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p4">7. She laid him in the manger - Perhaps it might rather be
translated in the stall. They were lodged in the ox stall, fitted up on
occasion of the great concourse, for poor guests. There was no room for
them in the inn - Now also, there is seldom room for Christ in an inn. <scripRef passage="Matt. i. 25" id="i.iv.iii-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|1|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.1.25">Matt. i, 25</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p5">11. To you - Shepherds; Israel; mankind.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p6">14. Glory be to God in the highest; on earth peace; good
will toward men - The shouts of the multitude are generally broken into
short sentences. This rejoicing acclamation strongly represents the
piety and benevolence of these heavenly spirits: as if they had said,
Glory be to God in the highest heavens: let all the angelic legions
resound his praises. For with the Redeemer's birth, peace, and all kind
of happiness, come down to dwell on earth: yea, the overflowings of
Divine good will and favour are now exercised toward men.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p7">20. For all the things that they had heard - From Mary; as
it was told them - By the angels.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p8">21. To circumcise the child - That he might visibly be made
under the law by a sacred rite, which obliged him to keep the whole law;
as also that he might be owned to be the seed of Abraham, and might put
an honour on the solemn dedication of children to God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p9">22. The days - The forty days prescribed, <scripRef passage="Lev. xii. 2, 4" id="i.iv.iii-p9.1" parsed="|Lev|12|2|0|0;|Lev|12|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.12.2 Bible:Lev.12.4">Lev. xii, 2, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p10">23. <scripRef passage="Exod. xiii. 2" id="i.iv.iii-p10.1" parsed="|Exod|13|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.13.2">Exod. xiii,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p11">24. A pair of turtle doves, or two young pigeons - This
offering sufficed for the poor. <scripRef passage="Lev. xii. 8" id="i.iv.iii-p11.1" parsed="|Lev|12|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.12.8">Lev.
xii, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p12">25. The consolation of Israel - A common phrase for the
Messiah, who was to be the everlasting consolation of the Israel of God.
The Holy Ghost was upon him - That is, he was a prophet.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p13">27. By the Spirit - By a particular Revelation or impulse
from him.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p14">30. Thy salvation - Thy Christ, thy saviour.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p15">32. And the glory of thy people Israel - For after the
Gentiles are enlightened, all Israel shall be saved.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p16">33. Joseph and his mother marvelled at those things which
were spoken - For they did not thoroughly understand them.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p17">34. Simeon blessed them - Joseph and Mary. This child is
set for the fall and rising again of many - That is, he will be a savour
of death to some, to unbelievers: a savour of life to others, to
believers: and for a sign which shall be spoken against - A sign from
God, yet rejected of men: but the time for declaring this at large was
not yet come: that the thoughts of many hearts may be revealed - The
event will be, that by means of that contradiction, the inmost thoughts
of many, whether good or bad, will be made manifest.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p18">35. A sword shall pierce through thy own soul - So it did,
when he suffered: particularly at his crucifixion.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p19">37. Fourscore and four years - These were the years of her
life, not her widowhood only. Who departed not from the temple - Who
attended there at all the stated hours of prayer. But served God with
fastings and prayers - Even at that age. Night and day - That is,
spending therein a considerable part of the night, as well as of the
day.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p20">38. To all that were waiting for redemption - The scepter
now appeared to be departing from Judah, though it was not actually
gone: Daniel's weeks were plainly near their period. And the revival of
the spirit of prophecy, together with the memorable occurrences relating
to the birth of John the Baptist, and of Jesus, could not but encourage
and quicken the expectation of pious persons at this time. Let the
example of these aged saints animate those, whose hoary heads, like
theirs, are a crown of glory, being found in the way of righteousness.
Let those venerable lips, so soon to be silent in the grave, be now
employed in the praises of their Redeemer. Let them labour to leave
those behind, to whom Christ will be as precious as he has been to them;
and who will be waiting for God's salvation, when they are gone to enjoy
it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p21">40. And the child grew - In bodily strength and stature;
and waxed strong in spirit - The powers of his human mind daily
improved; filled with wisdom - By the light of the indwelling Spirit,
which gradually opened itself in his soul; and the grace of God was upon
him - That is, the peculiar favour of God rested upon him, even as
man.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p22">43. The child Jesus - St. Luke describes in order Jesus the
fruit of the womb, chap. i, 42; an infant, chap. ii, 12; a little child,
ver. 40; a child here, and afterward a man. So our Lord passed through
and sanctified every stage of human life. Old age only did not become
him.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p23">44. Supposing him to have been in the company - As the men
and women usually travelled in distinct companies.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p24">46. After three days - The first day was spent in their
journey, the second, in their return to Jerusalem: and the third, in
searching for him there: they found him in the temple - In an apartment
of it: sitting in the midst of the doctors - Not one word is said of his
disputing with them, but only of his asking and answering questions,
which was a very usual thing in these assemblies, and indeed the very
end of them. And if he was, with others, at the feet of these teachers
(where learners generally sat) he might be said to be in the midst of
them, as they sat on benches of a semicircular form, raised above their
hearers and disciples.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p25">49. Why sought ye me? - He does not blame them for losing,
but for thinking it needful to seek him: and intimates, that he could
not be lost, nor found any where, but doing the will of a higher
parent.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p26">50. It is observable that Joseph is not mentioned after
this time; whence it is probable, he did not live long after.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iii-p27">52. Jesus increased in wisdom - As to his human nature, and
in favour with God - In proportion to that increase. It plainly follows,
that though a man were pure, even as Christ was pure, still he would
have room to increase in holiness, and in consequence thereof to
increase in the favour, as well as in the love of God.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="5.30%" prev="i.iv.iii" next="i.iv.v" id="i.iv.iv">
<h3 id="i.iv.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke III" id="i.iv.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3" /> 

<p id="i.iv.iv-p1">1. The fifteenth year of Tiberius - Reckoning from the time
when Angustus made him his colleague in the empire. Herod being tetrarch
of Galilee - The dominions of Herod the Great were, after his death,
divided into four parts or tetrarchies. This Herod his son was tetrarch
of Galilee, reigning over that fourth part of his dominions. His brother
reigned over two other fourth parts, the region of Iturea, and that of
Trachonitis (that tract of land on the other side Jordan, which had
formerly belonged to the tribe of Manasseh.) And Lysanias (probably
descended from a prince of that name, who was some years before governor
of that country) was tetrarch of the remaining part of Abilene, which
was a large city of Syria, whose territories reached to Lebanon and
Damascus, and contained great numbers of Jews. <scripRef passage="Matt. iii. 1" id="i.iv.iv-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.3.1">Matt. iii, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark i. 1" id="i.iv.iv-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.1">Mark i, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p2">2. Annas being high priest, and Caiaphas - There could be
but one high priest, strictly speaking, at once. Annas was the high
priest at that time, and Caiaphas his sagan or deputy.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p3">4. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 3" id="i.iv.iv-p3.1" parsed="|Isa|40|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.3">Isaiah xl,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p4">5. Every valley shall be filled, &amp;c. - That is, every
hindrance shall be removed.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p5">6. The salvation of God - The saviour, the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p6">8. Say not within yourselves, We have Abraham to our father
- That is, trust not in your being members of the visible Church, or in
any external privileges whatsoever: for God now requires a change of
heart; and that without delay.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p7">10. He answereth - It is not properly John, but the Holy
Ghost, who teaches us in the following answers, how to come ourselves,
and how to instruct other penitent sinners to come to Christ, that he
may give them rest. The sum of all this is, Cease to do evil, learn to
do well. These are the fruits worthy of repentance.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p8">20. He shut up John - This circumstance, though it happened
after, is here mentioned before our Lord's baptism, that his history
(that of John being concluded) may then follow without any
interruption.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p9">21. Jesus praying, the heaven was opened - It is
observable, that the three voices from heaven, see chap. ix, 29, 35; <scripRef passage="John xii. 28" id="i.iv.iv-p9.1" parsed="|John|12|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.28">John xii, 28</scripRef>; by which the Father bore witness to Christ, were pronounced
either while he was praying, or quickly after it. <scripRef passage="Matt. iii. 13" id="i.iv.iv-p9.2" parsed="|Matt|3|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.3.13">Matt.
iii, 13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark i. 9" id="i.iv.iv-p9.3" parsed="|Mark|1|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.9">Mark i,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p10">23. And Jesus was - John's beginning was computed by the
years of princes: our saviour's by the years of his own life, as a more
august era. About thirty years of age - He did not now enter upon his
thirtieth year (as the common translation would induce one to think) but
he now entered on his public ministry: being of such an age as the
Mosaic law required. Our great Master attained not, as it seems, to the
conclusion of his thirty-fourth year. Yet what glorious achievements did
he accomplish within those narrow limits of time! Happy that servant,
who, with any proportionable zeal, despatches the great business of
life; and so much the more happy, if his sun go down at noon. For the
space that is taken from the labours of time, shall be added to the
rewards of eternity. The son of Heli - That is, the son-in-law: for Heli
was the father of Mary. So St. Matthew writes the genealogy of Joseph,
descended from David by Solomon; St. Luke that of Mary, descended from
David by Nathan. In the genealogy of Joseph (recited by St. Matthew)
that of Mary is implied, the Jews being accustomed to marry into their
own families.</p>

<p id="i.iv.iv-p11">38. Adam the son of God - That is, whatever the sons of
Adam receive from their human parents, Adam received immediately from
God, except sin and misery.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="5.36%" prev="i.iv.iv" next="i.iv.vi" id="i.iv.v">
<h3 id="i.iv.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke IV" id="i.iv.v-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4" /> 

<p id="i.iv.v-p1">1. The wilderness - Supposed by some to have been in Judea;
by others to have been that great desert of Horeb or Sinai, where the
children of Israel were tried for forty years, and Moses and Elijah
fasted forty days. <scripRef passage="Matt. iv. 1" id="i.iv.v-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|4|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4.1">Matt. iv,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark i. 12" id="i.iv.v-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|1|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.12">Mark i, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p2">4. <scripRef passage="Deut. viii. 3" id="i.iv.v-p2.1" parsed="|Deut|8|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.8.3">Deut. viii,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p3">6. I give it to whomsoever I will - Not so, Satan. It is
God, not thou, that putteth down one, and setteth up another: although
sometimes Satan, by God's permission, may occasion great revolutions in
the world.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p4">8. <scripRef passage="Deut. vi. 13" id="i.iv.v-p4.1" parsed="|Deut|6|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.6.13">Deut. vi,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p5">10. <scripRef passage="Psalm xci. 11" id="i.iv.v-p5.1" parsed="|Ps|91|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.91.11">Psalm xci,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p6">12. <scripRef passage="Deut. vi. 16" id="i.iv.v-p6.1" parsed="|Deut|6|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.6.16">Deut. vi,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p7">13. A convenient season - In the garden of Gethsemane,
chap. xxii, 53.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p8">14. Jesus returned in the power of the Spirit - Being more
abundantly strengthened after his conflict.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p9">15. Being glorified of all - So God usually gives strong
cordials after strong temptations. But neither their approbation
continued long, nor the outward calm which he now enjoyed.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p10">16. He stood up - Showing thereby that he had a desire to
read the Scripture to the congregation: on which the book was given to
him. It was the Jewish custom to read standing, but to preach sitting. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 54" id="i.iv.v-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|13|54|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.54">Matt. xiii, 54</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 1" id="i.iv.v-p10.2" parsed="|Mark|6|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.1">Mark vi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p11">17. He found - It seems, opening upon it, by the particular
providence of God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p12">18. He hath anointed me - With the Spirit. He hath by the
power of his Spirit which dwelleth in me, set me apart for these
offices. To preach the Gospel to the poor - Literally and spiritually.
How is the doctrine of the ever-blessed trinity interwoven, even in
those scriptures where one would least expect it? How clear a
declaration of the great Three-One is there in those very words, The
Spirit - of the Lord is upon me! To proclaim deliverance to the
captives, and recovery of sight to the blind, to set at liberty them
that are bruised - Here is a beautiful gradation, in comparing the
spiritual state of men to the miserable state of those captives, who are
not only cast into prison, but, like Zedekiah, had their eyes put out,
and were laden and bruised with chains of iron. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxi. 1" id="i.iv.v-p12.1" parsed="|Isa|61|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.61.1">Isaiah lxi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p13">19. The acceptable year - Plainly alluding to the year of
jubilee, when all, both debtors and servants, were set free.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p14">21. Today is this scripture fulfilled in your ears - By
what you hear me speak.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p15">22. The gracious words which proceeded out of his mouth - A
person of spiritual discernment may find in all the discourses of our
Lord a peculiar sweetness, gravity, and becomingness, such as is not to
be found in the same degree, not even in those of the apostles.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p16">23. Ye will surely say - That is, your approbation now
outweighs your prejudices. But it will not be so long. You will soon
ask, why my love does not begin at home? Why I do not work miracles
here, rather than at Capernaum? It is because of your unbelief. Nor is
it any new thing for me to be despised in my own country. So were both
Elijah and Elisha, and thereby driven to work miracles among heathens,
rather than in Israel.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p17">24. No prophet is acceptable in his own country - That is,
in his own neighbourhood. It generally holds, that a teacher sent from
God is not so acceptable to his neighbours as he is to strangers. The
meanness of his family, or lowness of his circumstances, bring his
office into contempt: nor can they suffer that he, who was before equal
with, or below themselves, should now bear a superior character.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p18">25. When the heaven was shut up three years and six months
- Such a proof had they that God had sent him. In <scripRef passage="1 Kings xviii. 1" id="i.iv.v-p18.1" parsed="|1Kgs|18|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.18.1">1 Kings xviii, 1</scripRef>, it is said, The word of the Lord came to Elijah in the
third year: namely, reckoning not from the beginning of the drought, but
from the time when he began to sojourn with the widow of Sarepta. A year
of drought had preceded this, while he dwelt at the brook Cherith. So
that the whole time of the drought was (as St. James likewise observes)
three years and six months. <scripRef passage="1 Kings xvii. 19; xviii. 44" id="i.iv.v-p18.2" parsed="|1Kgs|17|19|0|0;|1Kgs|18|44|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.17.19 Bible:1Kgs.18.44">1 Kings xvii, 19; xviii, 44</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p19">27. <scripRef passage="2 Kings v. 14" id="i.iv.v-p19.1" parsed="|2Kgs|5|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.5.14">2 Kings v,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p20">28. And all in the synagogue were filled with fury -
Perceiving the purport of his discourse, namely, that the blessing which
they despised, would be offered to, and accepted by, the Gentiles. So
changeable are the hearts of wicked men! So little are their starts of
love to be depended on! So unable are they to bear the close
application, even of a discourse which they most admire!</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p21">30. Passing through the midst of them - Perhaps invisibly;
or perhaps they were overawed; so that though they saw, they could not
touch him.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p22">31. He came down to Capernaum - And dwelt there, entirely
quitting his abode at Nazareth. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 21" id="i.iv.v-p22.1" parsed="|Mark|1|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.21">Mark i,
21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p23">34. What have we to do with thee - Thy present business is
with men, not with devils. I know thee who thou art - But surely he did
not know a little before, that he was God over all, blessed forever; or
he would not have dared to tell him, All this power is delivered to me,
and I give it to whomsoever I will. The Holy One of God - Either this
confession was extorted from him by terror, (for the devils believe and
tremble, ) or he made it with a design to render the character of Christ
suspected. Possibly it was from hence the Pharisees took occasion to
say, He casteth out devils by the prince of the devils.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p24">38. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 14" id="i.iv.v-p24.1" parsed="|Matt|8|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.14">Matt. viii,
14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark i. 29" id="i.iv.v-p24.2" parsed="|Mark|1|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.29">Mark i, 29</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p25">40. When the sun was set - And consequently the Sabbath
ended, which they reckoned from sunset to sunset. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 16" id="i.iv.v-p25.1" parsed="|Matt|8|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.16">Matt. viii, 16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark i. 32" id="i.iv.v-p25.2" parsed="|Mark|1|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.32">Mark i, 32</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.v-p26">42. <scripRef passage="Mark i. 35" id="i.iv.v-p26.1" parsed="|Mark|1|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.35">Mark i,
35</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="5.46%" prev="i.iv.v" next="i.iv.vii" id="i.iv.vi">
<h3 id="i.iv.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke V" id="i.iv.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.5" /> 

<p id="i.iv.vi-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. iv. 18" id="i.iv.vi-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|4|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4.18">Matt. iv,
18</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark i. 16" id="i.iv.vi-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|1|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.16">Mark i, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p2">6. Their net brake - Began to tear.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p3">8. Depart from me, for I am a sinful man - And therefore
not worthy to be in thy presence.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p4">11. They forsook all and followed him - They had followed
him before, <scripRef passage="John i. 43" id="i.iv.vi-p4.1" parsed="|John|1|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.43">John i, 43</scripRef>, but not so as to forsake all. Till now, they wrought at
their ordinary calling.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p5">12. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 2" id="i.iv.vi-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|8|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.2">Matt. viii,
2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark i. 40" id="i.iv.vi-p5.2" parsed="|Mark|1|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.1.40">Mark i, 40</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p6">14. <scripRef passage="Lev. xiv. 2" id="i.iv.vi-p6.1" parsed="|Lev|14|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.14.2">Lev. xiv,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p7">16. He withdrew - The expression in the original implies,
that he did so frequently.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p8">17. Sitting by - As being more honourable than the bulk of
the congregation, who stood. And the power of the Lord was present to
heal them - To heal the sickness of their souls, as well as all bodily
diseases.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p9">18. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 2" id="i.iv.vi-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|9|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.2">Matt. ix, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ii. 3" id="i.iv.vi-p9.2" parsed="|Mark|2|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2.3">Mark ii, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p10">19. Not being able to bring him in through the multitude,
they went round about by a back passage, and going up the stairs on the
outside, they came upon the flat-roofed house, and let him down through
the trap door, such as was on the top of most of the Jewish houses:
doubtless, with such circumspection as the circumstances plainly
required.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p11">26. We have seen strange things today - Sins forgiven,
miracles wrought.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p12">27. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 9" id="i.iv.vi-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|9|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.9">Matt. ix, 9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ii. 14" id="i.iv.vi-p12.2" parsed="|Mark|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2.14">Mark ii, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p13">28. Leaving all - His business and gain.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p14">29. And Levi made him a great entertainment - It was
necessarily great, because of the great number of guests.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p15">33. Make prayers - Long and solemn. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 14" id="i.iv.vi-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|9|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.14">Matt. ix, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ii. 18" id="i.iv.vi-p15.2" parsed="|Mark|2|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2.18">Mark ii, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p16">34. Can ye make - That is, is it proper to make men fast
and mourn, during a festival solemnity?</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p17">36. He spake also a parable - Taken from clothes and wine;
therefore peculiarly proper at a feast.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vi-p18">39. And no man having drunk old wine - And beside, men are
not wont to be immediately freed from old prejudices.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="5.49%" prev="i.iv.vi" next="i.iv.viii" id="i.iv.vii">
<h3 id="i.iv.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke VI" id="i.iv.vii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6" /> 

<p id="i.iv.vii-p1">1. The first Sabbath - So the Jews reckoned their Sabbaths,
from the passover to pentecost; the first, second, third, and so on,
till the seventh Sabbath (after the second day.) This immediately
preceded pentecost, which was the fiftieth day after the second day of
unleavened bread. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 1" id="i.iv.vii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.1">Matt. xii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ii. 23" id="i.iv.vii-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|2|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.2.23">Mark ii,
23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p2">2. Why do ye - St. Matthew and Mark represent the Pharisees
as proposing the question to our Lord himself. It was afterward,
probably, they proposed it to his disciples.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p3">4. <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxi. 6" id="i.iv.vii-p3.1" parsed="|1Sam|21|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.21.6">1 Sam. xxi,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p4">6. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 9" id="i.iv.vii-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|12|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.9">Matt. xii,
9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 1" id="i.iv.vii-p4.2" parsed="|Mark|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.1">Mark iii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p5">9. To save life or to kill - He just then probably saw the
design to kill him rising in their hearts.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p6">12. In the prayer of God - The phrase is singular and
emphatical, to imply an extraordinary and sublime devotion. <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 13" id="i.iv.vii-p6.1" parsed="|Mark|3|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.13">Mark iii, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p7">13. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 2" id="i.iv.vii-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.2">Matt. x, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 14" id="i.iv.vii-p7.2" parsed="|Mark|3|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.14">Mark iii, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Acts i. 13" id="i.iv.vii-p7.3" parsed="|Acts|1|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1.13">Acts i, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p8">15. Simon called Zelotes - Full of zeal; otherwise called
Simon the Canaanite.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p9">17. On a plain - At the foot of the mountain.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p10">20. In the following verses our Lord, in the audience of
his newly- chosen disciples, and of the multitude, repeats, standing on
the plain, many remarkable passages of the sermon he had before
delivered, sitting on the mount. He here again pronounces the poor and
the hungry, the mourners, and the persecuted, happy; and represents as
miserable those who are rich, and full, and joyous, and applauded:
because generally prosperity is a sweet poison, and affliction a
healing, though bitter medicine. Let the thought reconcile us to
adversity, and awaken our caution when the world smiles upon us; when a
plentiful table is spread before us, and our cup is running over; when
our spirits are gay; and we hear (what nature loves) our own praise from
men. Happy are ye poor - The word seems here to be taken literally: ye
who have left all for me. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 3" id="i.iv.vii-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|5|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.3">Matt. v,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p11">24. Miserable are ye rich - If ye have received or sought
your consolation or happiness therein.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p12">25. Full - Of meat and drink, and worldly goods. That laugh
- That are of a light trifling spirit.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p13">26. Woe to you when all men shall speak well of you - But
who will believe this?</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p14">27. But I say to you that hear - Hitherto our Lord had
spoken only to particular sorts of persons: now he begins speaking to
all in general. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 44" id="i.iv.vii-p14.1" parsed="|Matt|5|44|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.44">Matt. v,
44</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p15">29. To him that smiteth thee on the cheek - Taketh away thy
cloak - These seem to be proverbial expressions, to signify an invasion
of the tenderest points of honour and property. Offer the other - Forbid
not thy coat - That is, rather yield to his repeating the affront or
injury, than gratify resentment in righting your self; in any method not
becoming Christian love. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 39" id="i.iv.vii-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|5|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.39">Matt. v,
39</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p16">30. Give to every one - Friend or enemy, what thou canst
spare, and he really wants: and of him that taketh away thy goods - By
borrowing, if he be insolvent, ask them not again. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 42" id="i.iv.vii-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|5|42|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.42">Matt. v, 42</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p17">31. <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 12" id="i.iv.vii-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|7|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.12">Matt. vii,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p18">32. It is greatly observable, our Lord has so little regard
for one of the highest instances of natural virtue, namely, the
returning love for love, that he does not account it even to deserve
thanks. For even sinners, saith he, do the same: men who do not regard
God at all. Therefore he may do this, who has not taken one step in
Christianity.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p19">37. <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 1" id="i.iv.vii-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.1">Matt. vii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p20">38. Into your bosom - Alluding to the mantles the Jews
wore, into which a large quantity of corn might be received. With the
same measure that ye mete with, it shall be measured to you again -
Amazing goodness! So we are permitted even to carve for ourselves! We
ourselves are, as it were, to tell God how much mercy he shall show us!
And can we be content with less than the very largest measure? Give then
to man, what thou designest to receive of God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p21">39. He spake a parable - Our Lord sometimes used parables
when he knew plain and open declarations would too much inflame the
passions of his hearers. It is for this reason he uses this parable, Can
the blind lead the blind? - Can the scribes teach this way, which they
know not themselves? Will not they and their scholars perish together?
Can they make their disciples any better than themselves? But as for
those who will be my disciples, they shall be all taught of God; who
will enable them to come to the measure of the stature of the fulness of
their Master. Be not ye like their disciples, censuring others, and not
amending yourselves. <scripRef passage="Matt. xv. 14" id="i.iv.vii-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|15|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.15.14">Matt. xv,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p22">40. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 24" id="i.iv.vii-p22.1" parsed="|Matt|10|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.24">Matt. x, 24</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xv. 20" id="i.iv.vii-p22.2" parsed="|John|15|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.15.20">John xv, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p23">41. <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 3" id="i.iv.vii-p23.1" parsed="|Matt|7|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.3">Matt. vii,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p24">46. And why call ye me Lord, Lord - What will fair
professions avail, without a life answerable thereto? <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 21" id="i.iv.vii-p24.1" parsed="|Matt|7|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.21">Matt. vii, 21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.vii-p25">47. <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 24" id="i.iv.vii-p25.1" parsed="|Matt|7|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.24">Matt. vii,
24</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="5.56%" prev="i.iv.vii" next="i.iv.ix" id="i.iv.viii">
<h3 id="i.iv.viii-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke VII" id="i.iv.viii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.7" /> 

<p id="i.iv.viii-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 5" id="i.iv.viii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|8|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.5">Matt. viii,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p2">3. Hearing of Jesus - Of his miracles, and of his arrival
at Capernaum.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p3">18. <scripRef passage="Matt. xi. 2" id="i.iv.viii-p3.1" parsed="|Matt|11|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.11.2">Matt. xi,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p4">22. To the poor the Gospel is preached - Which is the
greatest mercy, and the greatest miracle of all.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p5">24. When the messengers were departed - He did not speak
the following things in the hearing of John's disciples, lest he should
seem to flatter John, or to compliment him into an adherence to his
former testimony. To avoid all suspicion of this kind, he deferred his
commendation of him, till the messengers were gone; and then delivered
it to the people, to prevent all imaginations, as if John were wavering
in his judgment, and had sent the two disciples for his own, rather than
their satisfaction.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p6">27. <scripRef passage="Mal. iii. 1" id="i.iv.viii-p6.1" parsed="|Mal|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mal.3.1">Mal. iii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p7">28. There is not a greater prophet than John - A greater
teacher. But he that is least in the kingdom of God - The least teacher
whom I send forth.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p8">29. And all the people - Our Lord continues his discourse:
justified God - Owned his wisdom and mercy in thus calling them to
repentance, and preparing them for Him that was to come.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p9">30. But the Pharisees and scribes - The good, learned,
honourable men: made void the counsel, the gracious design, of God
toward them - They disappointed all these methods of his love, and would
receive no benefit from them.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p10">32. They are like children sitting in the market place - So
froward and perverse, that no contrivance can be found to please them.
It is plain our Lord means, that they were like the children complained
of, not like those that made the complaint.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p11">34. But wisdom is justified by all her children - The
children of wisdom are those who are truly wise unto salvation. The
wisdom of God in all these dispensations, these various methods of
calling sinners to repentance, is owned and heartily approved by all
these.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p12">36. And one of the Pharisees asked him to eat with him -
Let the candour with which our Lord accepted this invitation, and his
gentleness and prudence at this ensnaring entertainment, teach us to
mingle the wisdom of the serpent, with the innocence and sweetness of
the dove. Let us neither absolutely refuse all favours, nor resent all
neglects, from those whose friendship is at best very doubtful, and
their intimacy by no means safe.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p13">37. A woman - Not the same with Mary of Bethany, who
anointed him six days before his last passover.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p14">40. And Jesus said, Simon, I have somewhat to say to thee -
So tender and courteous an address does our Lord use even to a proud,
censorious Pharisee!</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p15">43. Which of them will love him most? - Neither of them
will love him at all, before he has forgiven them. An insolvent debtor,
till he is forgiven, does not love, but fly his creditor.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p16">44. Thou gavest me no water - It was customary with the
Jews to show respect and kindness to their welcome guests, by saluting
them with a kiss, by washing their feet, and anointing their heads with
oil, or some fine ointment.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p17">47. Those many sins of hers are forgiven; therefore she
loveth much - The fruit of her having had much forgiven. It should
carefully be observed here, that her love is mentioned as the effect and
evidence, not the cause of her pardon. She knew that much had been
forgiven her, and therefore she loved much.</p>

<p id="i.iv.viii-p18">50. Thy faith hath saved thee - Not thy love. Love is
salvation.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="5.62%" prev="i.iv.viii" next="i.iv.x" id="i.iv.ix">
<h3 id="i.iv.ix-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke VIII" id="i.iv.ix-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8" /> 

<p id="i.iv.ix-p1">2. Mary Magdalene - Or Mary of Magdala, a town in Galilee:
probably the person mentioned in the last chapter.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p2">4. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 1" id="i.iv.ix-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|13|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.1">Matt. xiii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 1" id="i.iv.ix-p2.2" parsed="|Mark|4|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.1">Mark iv, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p3">15. Who - keep it - Not like the highway side: And bring
forth fruit - Not like the thorny ground: With perseverance - Not like
the stony.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p4">16. No man having lighted a candle - As if he had said, And
let your good fruit appear openly. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 15" id="i.iv.ix-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|5|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.15">Matt.
v, 15</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 21" id="i.iv.ix-p4.2" parsed="|Mark|4|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.21">Mark iv,
21</scripRef>; Chap. xi, 33.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p5">17. For nothing is hid - Strive not to conceal it at all;
for you can conceal nothing long. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 26" id="i.iv.ix-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|10|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.26">Matt.
x, 26</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 22" id="i.iv.ix-p5.2" parsed="|Mark|4|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.22">Mark iv,
22</scripRef>; Chap. xii, 2.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p6">18. The word commonly translated seemeth, wherever it
occurs, does not weaken, but greatly strengthens the sense. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 12" id="i.iv.ix-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|13|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.12">Matt. xiii, 12</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 25" id="i.iv.ix-p6.2" parsed="|Mark|4|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.25">Mark iv, 25</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 26" id="i.iv.ix-p6.3" parsed="|Luke|19|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.26">Luke xix, 26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p7">19. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 46" id="i.iv.ix-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|12|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.46">Matt. xii,
46</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 31" id="i.iv.ix-p7.2" parsed="|Mark|3|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.31">Mark iii,
31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p8">22. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 23" id="i.iv.ix-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|8|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.23">Matt. viii,
23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 35" id="i.iv.ix-p8.2" parsed="|Mark|4|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.35">Mark iv,
35</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p9">26. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 28" id="i.iv.ix-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|8|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.28">Matt. viii,
28</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark v. 1" id="i.iv.ix-p9.2" parsed="|Mark|5|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.5.1">Mark v, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p10">29. For many times it had caught him - Therefore our
compassionate Lord made the more haste to cast him out.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p11">31. The abyss - That is, the bottomless pit.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p12">32. To enter into the swine - Not that they were any easier
in the swine than out of them. Had it been so, they would not so soon
have dislodged themselves, by destroying the herd.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p13">37. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 1" id="i.iv.ix-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|9|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.1">Matt. ix, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark v. 18" id="i.iv.ix-p13.2" parsed="|Mark|5|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.5.18">Mark v, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p14">40. <scripRef passage="Mark v. 21" id="i.iv.ix-p14.1" parsed="|Mark|5|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.5.21">Mark v,
21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.ix-p15">52. She is not dead but sleepeth - Her soul is not
separated finally from the body; and this short separation is rather to
be called sleep than death.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="5.65%" prev="i.iv.ix" next="i.iv.xi" id="i.iv.x">
<h3 id="i.iv.x-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke IX" id="i.iv.x-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9" /> 

<p id="i.iv.x-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 1" id="i.iv.x-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|10|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.1">Matt. x, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 7" id="i.iv.x-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|6|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.7">Mark vi, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p2">4. There abide and thence depart - That is, stay in that
house till ye leave the city.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p3">7. It was said by some - And soon after by Herod himself. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 1" id="i.iv.x-p3.1" parsed="|Matt|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.1">Matt. xiv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 14" id="i.iv.x-p3.2" parsed="|Mark|6|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.14">Mark
vi, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p4">8. That Elijah had appeared - He could not rise again,
because he did not die.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p5">10. <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 30" id="i.iv.x-p5.1" parsed="|Mark|6|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.30">Mark vi,
30</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p6">12. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 15" id="i.iv.x-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|14|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.15">Matt. xiv,
15</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 35" id="i.iv.x-p6.2" parsed="|Mark|6|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.35">Mark vi, 35</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John vi. 3" id="i.iv.x-p6.3" parsed="|John|6|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.6.3">John vi, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p7">18. Apart - From the multitude. And he asked them - When he
had done praying, during which they probably stayed at a distance. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 13" id="i.iv.x-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|14|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.13">Matt. xiv, 13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 27" id="i.iv.x-p7.2" parsed="|Mark|8|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.27">Mark viii, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p8">22. Saying - Ye must prepare for a scene far different from
this.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p9">23. Let him deny himself, and take up his cross - The
necessity of this duty has been shown in many places: the extent of it
is specified here, daily - Therefore that day is lost wherein no cross
is taken up.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p10">24. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 25" id="i.iv.x-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|16|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.25">Matt. xvi,
25</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 35" id="i.iv.x-p10.2" parsed="|Mark|8|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.35">Mark viii,
35</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xii. 25" id="i.iv.x-p10.3" parsed="|John|12|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.25">John xii,
25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p11">28. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 1" id="i.iv.x-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|17|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.1">Matt. xvii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 2" id="i.iv.x-p11.2" parsed="|Mark|9|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.2">Mark ix, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p12">31. In glory - Like Christ with whom they talked.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p13">32. They saw his glory - The very same expression in which
it is described by St. John, <scripRef passage="John i. 14" id="i.iv.x-p13.1" parsed="|John|1|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.14">John i,
14</scripRef>; and by St. Peter, <scripRef passage="2 Pet. i. 16" id="i.iv.x-p13.2" parsed="|2Pet|1|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.1.16">2 Pet.
i, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p14">34. A cloud came and overshadowed them all. And they, the
apostles, feared, while they (Moses and Elijah) entered into the cloud,
which took them away.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p15">37. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 14" id="i.iv.x-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|17|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.14">Matt. xvii,
14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 14" id="i.iv.x-p15.2" parsed="|Mark|9|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.14">Mark ix,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p16">44. Let these sayings sink down into your ears - That is,
consider them deeply. In joy remember the cross. So wisely does our Lord
balance praise with sufferings. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 22" id="i.iv.x-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|17|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.22">Matt.
xvii, 22</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 31" id="i.iv.x-p16.2" parsed="|Mark|9|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.31">Mark ix,
31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p17">46. And there arose a reasoning among them - This kind of
reasoning always arose at the most improper times that could be
imagined.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p18">47. <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 2" id="i.iv.x-p18.1" parsed="|Matt|18|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.2">Matt. xviii,
2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 37" id="i.iv.x-p18.2" parsed="|Mark|9|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.37">Mark ix,
37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p19">48. And said to them - If ye would be truly great, humble
yourselves to the meanest offices. He that is least in his own eyes
shall be great indeed.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p20">49. <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 38" id="i.iv.x-p20.1" parsed="|Mark|9|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.38">Mark ix,
38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p21">51. The days are fulfilled that he should be received up -
That is, the time of his passion was now at hand. St. Luke looks through
this, to the glory which was to follow. He steadfastly set his face -
Without fear of his enemies, or shame of the cross, <scripRef passage="Heb. xii. 2" id="i.iv.x-p21.1" parsed="|Heb|12|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.12.2">Heb. xii, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p22">52. He sent messengers to make ready - A lodging and
needful entertainment for him and those with him.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p23">53. His face was as though he would go to Jerusalem - It
plainly appeared, he was going to worship at the temple, and thereby, in
effect, to condemn the Samaritan worship at Mount Gerizim.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p24">54. As Elisha did - At or near this very place, which might
put it into the minds of the apostles to make the motion now, rather
than at any other time or place, where Christ had received the like
affront.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p25">55. Ye know not what manner of spirit - The spirit of
Christianity is. It is not a spirit of wrath and vengeance, but of
peace, and gentleness, and love.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p26">57. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 19" id="i.iv.x-p26.1" parsed="|Matt|8|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.19">Matt. viii,
19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p27">58. But Jesus said to him - First understand the terms:
consider on what conditions thou art to follow me.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p28">61. Suffer me first to bid them farewell that are in my
house - As Elisha did after Elijah had called him from the plough, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xix. 19" id="i.iv.x-p28.1" parsed="|1Kgs|19|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.19.19">1 Kings xix, 19</scripRef>; to which our Lord's answer seems to allude.</p>

<p id="i.iv.x-p29">62. Is fit for the kingdom of God - Either to propagate or
to receive it.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="5.70%" prev="i.iv.x" next="i.iv.xii" id="i.iv.xi">
<h3 id="i.iv.xi-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke X" id="i.iv.xi-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xi-p1">2. Pray ye the Lord of the harvest, that he would thrust
forth labourers - For God alone can do this: he alone can qualify and
commission men for this work. <scripRef passage="Matt. ix. 37" id="i.iv.xi-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|9|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.9.37">Matt. ix,
37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p2">3. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 16" id="i.iv.xi-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|10|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.16">Matt. x,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p3">4. Salute no man by the way - The salutations usual among
the Jews took up much time. But these had so much work to do in so short
a space, that they had not a moment to spare.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p4">6. A son of peace - That is, one worthy of it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p5">7. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 11" id="i.iv.xi-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|10|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.11">Matt. x,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p6">11. The kingdom of God is at hand - Though ye will not
receive it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p7">13. Woe to thee, Chorazin - The same declaration Christ had
made some time before. By repeating it now, he warns the seventy not to
lose time by going to those cities. <scripRef passage="Matt. xi. 21" id="i.iv.xi-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|11|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.11.21">Matt. xi, 21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p8">16. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 40" id="i.iv.xi-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|10|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.40">Matt. x, 40</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xiii. 20" id="i.iv.xi-p8.2" parsed="|John|13|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.13.20">John xiii, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p9">18. I beheld Satan - That is, when ye went forth, I saw the
kingdom of Satan, which was highly exalted, swiftly and suddenly cast
down.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p10">19. I give you power - That is, I continue it to you: and
nothing shall hurt you - Neither the power, nor the subtilty of
Satan.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p11">20. Rejoice not so much that the devils are subject to you,
as that your names are written in heaven - Reader, so is thine, if thou
art a true, believer. God grant it may never be blotted out!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p12">21. Lord of heaven and earth - In both of which thy kingdom
stands, and that of Satan is destroyed. That thou hast hid these things
- He rejoiced not in the destruction of the wise and prudent, but in the
display of the riches of God's grace to others, in such a manner as
reserves to Him the entire glory of our salvation, and hides pride from
man. <scripRef passage="Matt. xi. 25" id="i.iv.xi-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|11|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.11.25">Matt. xi, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p13">22. Who the Son is - Essentially one with the Father: who
the Father is - How great, how wise, how good!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p14">23. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 16" id="i.iv.xi-p14.1" parsed="|Matt|13|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.16">Matt. xiii,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p15">25. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxii. 35" id="i.iv.xi-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|22|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.22.35">Matt. xxii,
35</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 28" id="i.iv.xi-p15.2" parsed="|Mark|12|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.28">Mark xii,
28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p16">27. Thou shalt love the Lord thy God - That is, thou shalt
unite all the faculties of thy soul to render him the most intelligent
and sincere, the most affectionate and resolute service. We may safely
rest in this general sense of these important words, if we are not able
to fix the particular meaning of every single word. If we desire to do
this, perhaps the heart, which is a general expression, may be explained
by the three following, With all thy soul, with the warmest affection,
with all thy strength, the most vigourous efforts of thy will, and with
all thy mind or understanding, in the most wise and reasonable manner
thou canst; thy understanding guiding thy will and affections. <scripRef passage="Deut. vi. 5" id="i.iv.xi-p16.1" parsed="|Deut|6|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.6.5">Deut. vi, 5</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Lev. xix. 18" id="i.iv.xi-p16.2" parsed="|Lev|19|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.18">Lev. xix, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p17">28. Thou hast answered right; this do, and thou shalt live
- Here is no irony, but a deep and weighty truth. He, and he alone,
shall live forever, who thus loves God and his neighbour in the present
life.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p18">29. To justify himself - That is, to show he had done this.
<scripRef passage="Lev. xviii. 5" id="i.iv.xi-p18.1" parsed="|Lev|18|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.18.5">Lev. xviii, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p19">30. From Jerusalem to Jericho - The road from Jerusalem to
Jericho (about eighteen miles from it) lay through desert and rocky
places: so many robberies and murders were committed therein, that it
was called the bloody way. Jericho was situated in the valley: hence the
phrase of going down to it. About twelve thousand priests and Levites
dwelt there, who all attended the service of the temple.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p20">31. The common translation is, by chance - Which is full of
gross improprieties. For if we speak strictly, there is no such thing in
the universe as either chance or fortune. A certain priest came down
that way, and passed by on the other side - And both he and the Levite
no doubt could find an excuse for passing over on the other side, and
might perhaps gravely thank God for their own deliverance, while they
left their brother bleeding to death. Is it not an emblem of many living
characters, perhaps of some who bear the sacred office? O house of Levi
and of Aaron, is not the day coming, when the virtues of heathens and
Samaritans will rise up in judgment against you?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p21">33. But a certain Samaritan came where he was - It was
admirably well judged to represent the distress on the side of the Jew,
and the mercy on that of the Samaritan. For the case being thus
proposed, self interest would make the very scribe sensible, how amiable
such a conduct was, and would lay him open to our Lord's inference. Had
it been put the other way, prejudice might more easily have interposed,
before the heart could have been affected.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p22">34. Pouring in oil and wine - Which when well beaten
together are one of the best balsams that can be applied to a fresh
wound.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p23">36. Which of these was the neighbour to him that fell among
the robbers - Which acted the part of a neighbour?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p24">37. And he said, He that showed mercy on him - He could not
for shame say otherwise, though he thereby condemned himself and
overthrew his own false notion of the neighbour to whom our love is due.
Go and do thou in like manner - Let us go and do likewise, regarding
every man as our neighbour who needs our assistance. Let us renounce
that bigotry and party zeal which would contract our hearts into an
insensibility for all the human race, but a small number whose
sentiments and practices are so much our own, that our love to them is
but self love reflected. With an honest openness of mind let us always
remember that kindred between man and man, and cultivate that happy
instinct whereby, in the original constitution of our nature, God has
strongly bound us to each other.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p25">40. Martha was encumbered - The Greek word properly
signifies to be drawn different ways at the same time, and admirably
expresses the situation of a mind, surrounded (as Martha's then was)
with so many objects of care, that it hardly knows which to attend to
first.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p26">41. Martha, Martha - There is a peculiar spirit and
tenderness in the repetition of the word: thou art careful, inwardly,
and hurried, outwardly.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xi-p27">42. Mary hath chosen the good part - To save her soul.
Reader, hast thou?</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="5.80%" prev="i.iv.xi" next="i.iv.xiii" id="i.iv.xii">
<h3 id="i.iv.xii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XI" id="i.iv.xii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xii-p1">1. Lord, teach us to pray, as John also taught his
disciples - The Jewish masters used to give their followers some short
form of prayer, as a peculiar badge of their relation to them. This it
is probable John the Baptist had done. And in this sense it seems to be
that the disciples now asked Jesus, to teach them to pray. Accordingly
he here repeats that form, which he had before given them in his sermon
on the mount, and likewise enlarges on the same head, though still
speaking the same things in substance. And this prayer uttered from the
heart, and in its true and full meaning, is indeed the badge of a real
Christian: for is not he such whose first and most ardent desire is the
glory of God, and the happiness of man by the coming of his kingdom? Who
asks for no more of this world than his daily bread, longing meantime
for the bread that came down from heaven? And whose only desires for
himself are forgiveness of sins, (as he heartily forgives others, ) and
sanctification.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p2">2. When ye pray, say - And what he said to them is
undoubtedly said to us also. We are therefore here directed, not only to
imitate this in all our prayers, but to use this very form of prayer. <scripRef passage="Matt. vi. 9" id="i.iv.xii-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|6|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.6.9">Matt. vi, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p3">4. Forgive us; for we forgive them - Not once, but
continually. This does not denote the meritorious cause of our pardon;
but the removal of that hindrance which otherwise would render it
impossible.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p4">5. At midnight - The most unseasonable time: but no time is
unseasonable with God, either for hearing or answering prayer.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p5">9. <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 7" id="i.iv.xii-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|7|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.7">Matt. vii,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p6">13. How much more shall your heavenly Father - How
beautiful is the gradation! A friend: a father: God! Give the Holy
Spirit - The best of gifts, and that which includes every good gift.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p7">14. It was dumb - That is, it made the man so. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 22" id="i.iv.xii-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|12|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.22">Matt. xii, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p8">15. But some said, He casteth out devils by Beelzebub -
These he answers, ver. 17. Others, to try whether it were so or no,
sought a sign from heaven. These he reproves in ver. 29 and following
verses. Beelzebub signifies the Lord of flies, a title which the
heathens gave to Jupiter, whom they accounted the chief of their gods,
and yet supposed him to be employed in driving away flies from their
temple and sacrifices. The Philistines worshipped a deity under this
name, as the God of Ekron: from hence the Jews took the name, and
applied it to the chief of the devils. <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 22" id="i.iv.xii-p8.1" parsed="|Mark|3|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.22">Mark iii, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p9">16. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 38" id="i.iv.xii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|12|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.38">Matt. xii,
38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p10">17. A house - That is, a family.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p11">20. If I cast out devils by the finger of God - That is, by
a power manifestly Divine. Perhaps the expression intimates farther,
that it was done without any labour: then the kingdom of God is come
upon you - Unawares, unexpected: so the Greek word implies.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p12">21. The strong one armed - The devil, strong in himself,
and armed with the pride, obstinacy, and security of him in whom he
dwells.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p13">26. The last state of that man becometh worse than the
first - Whoever reads the sad account Josephus gives of the temple and
conduct of the Jews, after the ascension of Christ and before their
final destruction by the Romans, must acknowledge that no emblem could
have been more proper to describe them. Their characters were the vilest
that can be conceived, and they pressed on to their own ruin, as if they
had been possessed by legions of devils, and wrought up to the last
degree of madness. But this also is fulfilled in all who totally and
finally apostatize from true faith.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p14">27. Blessed is the womb that bare thee, and the paps which
thou hast sucked! - How natural was the thought for a woman! And how
gently does our Lord reprove her!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p15">28. Yea, rather blessed are they that hear the word of God
and keep it - For if even she that bare him had not done this, she would
have forfeited all her blessedness.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p16">29. It seeketh - The original word implies seeking more, or
over and above what one has already.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p17">32. They repented at the preaching of Jonah - But it was
only for a season. Afterward they relapsed into wickedness, till (after
about forty years) they were destroyed. It is remarkable, that in this
also the comparison held. God reprieved the Jews for about forty years;
but they still advanced in wickedness, till having filled up their
measure, they were destroyed with an utter destruction.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p18">33. The meaning is, God gives you this Gospel light, that
you may repent. Let your eye be singly fixed on him, aim only at
pleasing God; and while you do this, your whole soul will be full of
wisdom, holiness, and happiness. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 15" id="i.iv.xii-p18.1" parsed="|Matt|5|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.15">Matt.
v, 15</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 21" id="i.iv.xii-p18.2" parsed="|Mark|4|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.21">Mark iv,
21</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 16" id="i.iv.xii-p18.3" parsed="|Luke|8|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.16">Luke viii, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p19">34. But when thine eye is evil - When thou aimest at any
thing else, thou wilt be full of folly, sin, and misery. On the
contrary, <scripRef passage="Matt. vi. 22" id="i.iv.xii-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|6|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.6.22">Matt. vi, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p20">36. If thy whole body be full of light - If thou art filled
with holy wisdom, having no part dark, giving way to no sin or folly,
then that heavenly principle will, like the clear flame of a lamp in a
room that was dark before, shed its light into all thy powers and
faculties.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p21">39. Now ye Pharisees - Probably many of them were present
at the Pharisee's house. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 25" id="i.iv.xii-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|23|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.25">Matt.
xxiii, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p22">41. Give what is in them - The vessels which ye clean, in
alms, and all things are clean to you. As if he had said, By acts
directly contrary to rapine and wickedness, show that your hearts are
cleansed, and these outward washings are needless.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p23">42. Woe to you - That is, miserable are you. In the same
manner is the phrase to be understood throughout the chapter.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p24">44. For ye are as graves which appear not - Probably in
speaking this our Lord fixed his eyes on the scribes. As graves which
appear not, being overgrown with grass, so that men are not aware, till
they stumble upon them, and either hurt themselves, or at least are
defiled by touching them. On another occasion Christ compared them to
whited sepulchres, fair without, but foul within; <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 27" id="i.iv.xii-p24.1" parsed="|Matt|23|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.27">Matt. xxiii, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p25">45. One of the lawyers - That is scribes; expounders of the
law.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p26">48. Whom they killed, ye build their sepulchres - Just like
them pretending great reverence for the ancient prophets, while ye
destroy those whom God sends to yourselves. Ye therefore bear witness by
this deep hypocrisy that ye are of the very same spirit with them.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p27">49. The wisdom of God, agreeably to this, hath said - In
many places of Scripture, though not in these very words, I will send
them prophets - Chiefly under the Old Testament: and apostles - Under
the New. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 34" id="i.iv.xii-p27.1" parsed="|Matt|23|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.34">Matt. xxiii,
34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p28">50. The blood of all shall be required of this generation -
That is, shall be visibly and terribly punished upon it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p29">51. And so it was within forty years, in a most astonishing
manner, by the dreadful destruction of the temple, the city, and the
whole nation. Between the temple and the altar - In the court of the
temple.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xii-p30">52. Ye have taken away the key of knowledge - Ye have
obscured and destroyed the knowledge of the Messiah, which is the key of
both the present and the future kingdom of heaven; the kingdom of grace
and glory. Ye have not entered in - Into the present kingdom of
heaven.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="5.92%" prev="i.iv.xii" next="i.iv.xiv" id="i.iv.xiii">
<h3 id="i.iv.xiii-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XII" id="i.iv.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p1">1. He said to his disciples first - But afterward ver. 54
to all the people. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 6" id="i.iv.xiii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|16|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.6">Matt. xvi,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p2">3. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 27" id="i.iv.xiii-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|10|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.27">Matt. x,
27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p3">4. But I say to you, Fear not - Let not the fear of man
make you act the hypocrite, or conceal any thing which I have
commissioned you to publish.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p4">5. Fear him who hath power to cast into hell - Even to his
peculiar friends, Christ gives this direction. Therefore the fearing of
God as having power to cast into hell, is to be pressed even on true
believers.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p5">6. Are not five sparrows - But trust as well as fear
him.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p6">7. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 30" id="i.iv.xiii-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|10|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.30">Matt. x,
30</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p7">8. And I say to you - If you avoid all hypocrisy, and
openly avow my Gospel: The Son of man shall confess you - before the
angels - At the last day. <scripRef passage="Mark viii. 38" id="i.iv.xiii-p7.1" parsed="|Mark|8|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.8.38">Mark viii,
38</scripRef>; Chap. ix, 26.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p8">10. And whosoever - As if he had said, Yet the denying me
in some degree, may, upon true repentance, be forgiven; but if it rise
so high as that of the blasphemy against the Holy Ghost, it shall never
be forgiven, neither is there place for repentance. <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 31" id="i.iv.xiii-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|12|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.31">Matt. xii, 31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 28" id="i.iv.xiii-p8.2" parsed="|Mark|3|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.28">Mark iii,
28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p9">11. Take no thought - Be not solicitous about the matter or
manner of your defense; nor how to express yourselves. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 19" id="i.iv.xiii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|10|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.19">Matt. x, 19</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 12" id="i.iv.xiii-p9.2" parsed="|Luke|21|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.12">Luke xxi,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p10">14. Who made me a judge? - In worldly things. His kingdom
is not of this world.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p11">15. He said to them - Perhaps to the two brothers, and
through them to the people. A man's life - That is, the comfort or
happiness of it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p12">17. What shall I do? - The very language of want! Do? Why,
lay up treasure in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p13">20. Thou fool - To think of satisfying thy soul with
earthly goods! To depend on living many years! Yea, one day! They - The
messengers of death, commissioned by God, require thy soul of thee!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p14">21. Rich toward God - Namely, in faith, and love, and good
works.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p15">22. <scripRef passage="Matt. vi. 25" id="i.iv.xiii-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|6|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.6.25">Matt. vi,
25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p16">25. Which of you can add the least measure - It seems, to
add one cubit to a thing (which is the phrase in the original) was a
kind of proverbial expression for making the least addition to it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p17">28. The grass - The Greek word means all sorts of herbs and
flowers.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p18">29. Neither be ye of a doubtful mind - The word in the
original signifies, any speculations or musings in which the mind
fluctuates, or is suspended (like meteors in the air) in an uneasy
hesitation.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p19">32. It is your Father's good pleasure to give you the
kingdom - How much more food and raiment? And since ye have such an
inheritance, regard not your earthly possessions.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p20">33. Sell what ye have - This is a direction, not given to
all the multitude: (much less is it a standing rule for all Christians:)
neither to the apostles; for they had nothing to sell, having left all
before: but to his other disciples, (mentioned chap. xii, 22, and <scripRef passage="Acts i. 15" id="i.iv.xiii-p20.1" parsed="|Acts|1|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1.15">Acts i, 15</scripRef>, ) especially to the seventy, that they might be free from
all worldly entanglements. <scripRef passage="Matt. vi. 19" id="i.iv.xiii-p20.2" parsed="|Matt|6|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.6.19">Matt. vi, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p21">35. Let your loins be girt - An allusion to the long
garments, worn by the eastern nations, which they girded or tucked up
about their loins, when they journeyed or were employed in any labour:
as also to the lights that servants used to carry at weddings, which
were generally in the night.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p22">37. He will come and serve them - The meaning is, he will
show them his love, in the most condescending and tender manner.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p23">38. The Jews frequently divided the night into three
watches, to which our Lord seems here to allude.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p24">41. Speakest thou this parable to us - Apostles and
disciples: Or to all - The people? Does it concern us alone? Or all
men?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p25">42. Who is that faithful and wise steward - Our Lord's
answer manifestly implies, that he had spoken this parable primarily
(though not wholly) to the ministers of his word: Whom his Lord shall
make ruler over his household - For his wisdom and faithfulness.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p26">43. Happy is that servant - God himself pronounces him
wise, faithful, happy! Yet we see, he might fall from all, and perish
forever.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p27">46. The Lord will appoint him his portion - His everlasting
portion, with the unfaithful - As faithful as he was once, God himself
being the Judge!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p28">47. And that servant who knew his Lord's will shall be
beaten with many stripes - And his having much knowledge will increase,
not lessen, his punishment.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p29">49. I am come to send fire - To spread the fire of heavenly
love over all the earth.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p30">50. But I have a baptism to be baptized with - I must
suffer first, before I can set up my kingdom. And how I long to fight my
way through all!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p31">51. Suppose ye that I am come to send peace upon earth -
That universal peace will be the immediate effect of my coming? Not so,
but quite the contrary. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 34" id="i.iv.xiii-p31.1" parsed="|Matt|10|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.34">Matt. x,
34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p32">52. There shall be five in one house, three against two,
and two against three - There being an irreconcilable enmity between the
Spirit of Christ and the spirit of the world.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p33">53. The father against the son - For those who reject me
will be implacable toward their very nearest relations who receive me.
At this day also is this scripture fulfilled. Now likewise there is no
concord between Christ and Belial.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p34">54. And he said to the people also - In the preceding
verses he speaks only to his disciples. From the west - In Judea, the
west wind, blowing from the sea, usually brought rain: the south wind,
blowing from the deserts of Arabia, occasioned sultry heat. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 2" id="i.iv.xiii-p34.1" parsed="|Matt|16|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.2">Matt. xvi, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p35">56. How do ye not discern this season - Of the Messiah's
coming, distinguishable by so many surer signs.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p36">57. Why even of yourselves, without any external sign,
judge ye not what is right? - Why do ye not discern and acknowledge the
intrinsic excellence of my doctrine?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p37">58. When thou art going - As if he had said, And ye have
not a moment to lose. For the executioners of God's vengeance are at
hand. And when he hath once delivered you over to them, ye are undone
forever. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 25" id="i.iv.xiii-p37.1" parsed="|Matt|5|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.25">Matt. v, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiii-p38">59. A mite - was about the third part of a farthing
sterling.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="6.03%" prev="i.iv.xiii" next="i.iv.xv" id="i.iv.xiv">
<h3 id="i.iv.xiv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XIII" id="i.iv.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p1">1. The Galileans, whose blood Pilate had mingled with their
sacrifices - Some of the followers of Judas Gaulonites. They absolutely
refused to own the Roman authority. Pilate surrounded and slew them,
while they were worshipping in the temple, at a public feast.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p2">3. Ye shall all likewise perish - All ye of Galilee and of
Jerusalem shall perish in the very same manner. So the Greek word
implies. And so they did. There was a remarkable resemblance between the
fate of these Galileans and of the main body of the Jewish nation; the
flower of which was slain at Jerusalem by the Roman sword, while they
were assembled at one of their great festivals. And many thousands of
them perished in the temple itself, and were literally buried under its
ruins.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p3">6. A man had a fig tree - Either we may understand God the
Father by him that had the vineyard, and Christ by him that kept it: or
Christ himself is he that hath it, and his ministers they that keep it. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxx. 8" id="i.iv.xiv-p3.1" parsed="|Ps|80|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.80.8">Psalm lxxx, 8</scripRef>. &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p4">7. Three years - Christ was then in the third year of his
ministry. But it may mean only several years; a certain number being put
for an uncertain. Why doth it also cumber the ground? - That is, not
only bear no fruit itself, but take up the ground of another tree that
would.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p5">11. She was bowed together, and utterly unable to lift up
herself - The evil spirit which possessed her afflicted her in this
manner. To many doubtless it appeared a natural distemper. Would not a
modern physician have termed it a nervous case?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p6">15. Thou hypocrite - For the real motive of his speaking
was envy, not (as he pretended) pure zeal for the glory of God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p7">16. And ought not this woman? - Ought not any human
creature, which is so far better than an ox or an ass? Much more, this
daughter of Abraham - probably in a spiritual as well as natural sense,
to be loosed?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p8">18. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 31" id="i.iv.xiv-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|13|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.31">Matt. xiii,
31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iv. 30" id="i.iv.xiv-p8.2" parsed="|Mark|4|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.4.30">Mark iv,
30</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p9">20. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 33" id="i.iv.xiv-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|13|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.33">Matt. xiii,
33</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p10">21. Covered up - So that, for a time, nothing of it
appeared.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p11">24. Strive to enter in - Agonize. Strive as in an agony. So
the word signifies Otherwise none shall enter in. Barely seeking will
not avail. <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 13" id="i.iv.xiv-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|7|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.13">Matt. vii,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p12">25. And even agonizing will not avail, after the door is
shut. Agonize, therefore, now by faith, prayer, holiness, patience. And
ye begin to stand without - Till then they had not thought of it! O how
new will that sense of their misery be? How late? How lasting? I know
not whence ye are - I know not, that is, I approve not of your ways.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p13">27. <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 23" id="i.iv.xiv-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|7|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.23">Matt. vii,
23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p14">28. <scripRef passage="Matt. viii. 11" id="i.iv.xiv-p14.1" parsed="|Matt|8|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.8.11">Matt. viii,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p15">29. They shall sit down in the kingdom of God - Both the
kingdom of grace and of glory.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p16">30. But there are last - Many of the Gentiles who were
latest called, shall be most highly rewarded; and many of the Jews who
were first called, shall have no reward at all. <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 30" id="i.iv.xiv-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|19|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.30">Matt. xix, 30</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p17">31. Herod is minded to kill thee - Possibly they gave him
the caution out of good will.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p18">32. And he said, Go and tell that fox - With great
propriety so called, for his subtilty and cowardice. The meaning of our
Lord's answer is, Notwithstanding all that he can do, I shall for the
short time I have left, do the works of him that sent me. When that time
is fulfilled, I shall be offered up. Yet not here, but in the bloody
city. Behold, I cast out devils - With what majesty does he speak to his
enemies! With what tenderness to his friends! The third day I am
perfected - On the third day he left Galilee, and set out for Jerusalem,
to die there. But let us carefully distinguish between those things
wherein Christ is our pattern, and those which were peculiar to his
office. His extraordinary office justified him in using that severity of
language, when speaking of wicked princes, and corrupt teachers, to
which we have no call; and by which we should only bring scandal on
religion, and ruin on ourselves, while we irritated rather than
convinced or reformed those whom we so indecently rebuked.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p19">33. It cannot be, that a prophet perish out of Jerusalem -
Which claims prescription for murdering the messengers of God. Such
cruelty and malice cannot be found elsewhere.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p20">34. How often would I have gathered thy children together -
Three solemn visits he had made to Jerusalem since his baptism for this
very purpose. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 37" id="i.iv.xiv-p20.1" parsed="|Matt|23|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.37">Matt. xxiii,
37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xiv-p21">35. Your house is left to you desolate - Is now
irrecoverably consigned to desolation and destruction: And verily I say
to you, after a very short space, ye shall not see me till the time
come, when taught by your calamities, ye shall be ready and disposed to
say, Blessed is he that cometh in the name of the Lord. It does not
imply, that they should then see Jesus at all; but only that they would
earnestly wish for the Messiah, and in their extremity be ready to
entertain any who should assume that character.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="6.11%" prev="i.iv.xiv" next="i.iv.xvi" id="i.iv.xv">
<h3 id="i.iv.xv-p0.1">XIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XIV" id="i.iv.xv-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.14" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xv-p1">2. There was a certain man before him - It does not appear
that he was come thither with any insidious design. Probably he came,
hoping for a cure, or perhaps was one of the family.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p2">3. And Jesus answering, spake - Answering the thoughts
which he saw rising in their hearts.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p3">7. He spake a parable - The ensuing discourse is so termed,
because several parts are not to be understood literally. The general
scope of it is, Not only at a marriage feast, but on every occasion, he
that exalteth himself shall be abased, and he that abaseth himself shall
be exalted.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p4">11. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 12" id="i.iv.xv-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|23|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.12">Matt. xxiii,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p5">12. Call not thy friends - That is, I do not bid thee call
thy friends or thy neighbours. Our Lord leaves these offices of humanity
and courtesy as they were, and teaches a higher duty. But is it not
implied herein, that we should be sparing in entertaining those that
need it not, in order to assist those that do need, with all that is
saved from those needless entertainments? Lest a recompense be made -
This fear is as much unknown to the world, as even the fear of
riches.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p6">14. One of them that sat at table hearing these things -
And being touched therewith, said, Happy is he that shall eat bread in
the kingdom of God - Alluding to what had just been spoken. It means, he
that shall have a part in the resurrection of the just.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p7">16. Then said he - Continuing the allusion. A certain man
made a great supper - As if he had said, All men are not sensible of
this happiness. Many might have a part in it, and will not.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p8">18. They all began to make excuse - One of them pleads only
his own will, I go: another, a pretended necessity, I must needs go: the
third, impossibility, I cannot come: all of them want the holy hatred
mentioned ver. 26. All of them perish by things in themselves lawful. I
must needs go - The most urgent worldly affairs frequently fall out just
at the time when God makes the freest offers of salvation.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p9">21. The servant came and showed his Lord these things - So
ministers ought to lay before the Lord in prayer the obedience or
disobedience of their hearers.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p10">23. Compel them to come in - With all the violence of love,
and the force of God's word. Such compulsion, and such only, in matters
of religion, was used by Christ and his apostles.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p11">24. For refers to Go out, ver. 23.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p12">26. If any man come to me, and hate not his father -
Comparatively to Christ: yea, so as actually to renounce his field,
oxen, wife, all things, and act as if he hated them, when they stand in
competition with him. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 37" id="i.iv.xv-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|10|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.37">Matt. x,
37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p13">28. And which of you intending to build a tower - That is,
and whoever of you intends to follow me, let him first seriously weigh
these things.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p14">31. Another king - Does this mean, the prince of this
world? Certainly he has greater numbers on his side. How numerous are
his children and servants!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p15">33. So - Like this man, who, being afraid to face his
enemy, sends to make peace with him, every one who forsaketh not all
that he hath -</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.xv-p16">1. By withdrawing his affections from all the
creatures;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.xv-p17">2. By enjoying them only in and for God, only
in such a measure and manner as leads to him;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.xv-p18">3. By hating them all, in the sense above
mentioned, cannot be my disciple - But will surely desist from building
that tower, neither can he persevere in fighting the good fight of
faith.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xv-p19">34. Salt - Every Christian, but more eminently every
minister. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 13" id="i.iv.xv-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|5|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.13">Matt. v, 13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 50" id="i.iv.xv-p19.2" parsed="|Mark|9|50|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.50">Mark ix, 50</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="6.17%" prev="i.iv.xv" next="i.iv.xvii" id="i.iv.xvi">
<h3 id="i.iv.xvi-p0.1">XV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XV" id="i.iv.xvi-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.15" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p1">1. All the publicans - That is, all who were in that place.
It seems our Lord was in some town of Galilee of the Gentiles, from
whence he afterward went to Jerusalem, chap. xvii, 11.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p2">3. He spake - Three parables of the same import: for the
sheep, the piece of silver, and the lost son, all declare (in direct
contrariety to the Pharisees and scribes) in what manner God receiveth
sinners.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p3">4. Leave the ninety and nine in the wilderness - Where they
used to feed: all uncultivated ground, like our commons, was by the Jews
termed wilderness or desert. And go after - In recovering a lost soul,
God as it were labours. May we not learn hence, that to let them alone
who are in sin, is both unchristian and inhuman! <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 12" id="i.iv.xvi-p3.1" parsed="|Matt|18|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.12">Matt. xviii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p4">7. Joy shall be - Solemn and festal joy, in heaven - First,
in our blessed Lord himself, and then among the angels and spirits of
just men, perhaps informed thereof by God himself, or by the angels who
ministered to them. Over one sinner - One gross, open, notorious sinner,
that repenteth - That is, thoroughly changed in heart and life; more
than over ninety and nine just persons - Comparatively just, outwardly
blameless: that need not such a repentance - For they need not, cannot
repent of the sins which they never committed. The sum is, as a father
peculiarly rejoices when an extravagant child, supposed to be utterly
lost, comes to a thorough sense of his duty; or as any other person who
has recovered what he had given up for gone, has a more sensible
satisfaction in it, than in several other things equally valuable, but
not in such danger: so do the angels in heaven peculiarly rejoice in the
conversion of the most abandoned sinners. Yea, and God himself so
readily forgives and receives them, that he may be represented as having
part in the joy.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p5">12. Give me the part of goods that falleth to me - See the
root of all sin! A desire of disposing of ourselves; of independency on
God!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p6">13. He took a journey into a far country - Far from God:
God was not in all his thoughts: And squandered away his substance - All
the grace he had received.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p7">14. He began to be in want - All his worldly pleasures
failing, he grew conscious of his want of real good.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p8">15. And he joined himself to a citizen of that country -
Either the devil or one of his children, the genuine citizens of that
country which is far from God. He sent him to feed swine - He employed
him in the base drudgery of sin.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p9">16. He would fain have filled his belly with the husks - He
would fain have satisfied himself with worldly comforts. Vain, fruitless
endeavour!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p10">17. And coming to himself - For till then he was beside
himself, as all men are, so long as they are without God in the
world.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p11">18. I will arise and go to my father - How accurately are
the first steps of true repentance here pointed out! Against Heaven -
Against God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p12">20. And he arose and came to his father - The moment he had
resolved, he began to execute his resolution. While he was yet a great
way off, his father saw him - Returning, starved, naked.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p13">22. But the father said - Interrupting him before he had
finished what he intended to say. So does God frequently cut an earnest
confession short by a display of his pardoning love.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p14">23. Let us be merry - Both here, and wherever else this
word occurs, whether in the Old or New Testament, it implies nothing of
levity, but a solid, serious, religious, heartfelt joy: indeed this was
the ordinary meaning of the word two hundred years ago, when our
translation was made.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p15">25. The elder son seems to represent the Pharisees and
scribes, mentioned chap. xv, 2.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p16">27. Thy father hath killed the fatted calf - Perhaps he
mentions this rather than the robe or ring, as having a nearer
connection with the music and dancing.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p17">28. He was angry, and would not go in - How natural to us
is this kind of resentment!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p18">29. Lo, so many years do I serve thee - So he was one of
the instances mentioned ver. 7. How admirably therefore does this
parable confirm that assertion! Yet thou never gavest me a kid, that I
might make merry with my friends - Perhaps God does not usually give
much joy to those who never felt the sorrows of repentance.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p19">31. Thou art ever with me, and all that I have is thine -
This suggests a strong reason against murmuring at the indulgence shown
to the greatest of sinners. As the father's receiving the younger son
did not cause him to disinherit the elder; so God's receiving notorious
sinners will be no loss to those who have always served him; neither
will he raise these to a state of glory equal to that of those who have
always served him, if they have, upon the whole, made a greater progress
in inward as well as outward holiness.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvi-p20">32. This thy brother was dead, and is alive - A thousand of
these delicate touches in the inspired writings escape an inattentive
reader. In ver. 30, the elder son had unkindly and indecently said, This
thy son. The father in his reply mildly reproves him, and tenderly says,
This thy brother - Amazing intimation, that the best of men ought to
account the worst sinners their brethren still; and should especially
remember this relation, when they show any inclination to return. Our
Lord in this whole parable shows, not only that the Jews had no cause to
murmur at the reception of the Gentiles, (a point which did not at that
time so directly fall under consideration, ) but that if the Pharisees
were indeed as good as they fancied themselves to be, still they had no
reason to murmur at the kind treatment of any sincere penitent. Thus
does he condemn them, even on their own principles, and so leaves them
without excuse. We have in this parable a lively emblem of the condition
and behaviour of sinners in their natural state. Thus, when enriched by
the bounty of the great common Father, do they ungratefully run from
him, ver. 12. Sensual pleasures are eagerly pursued, till they have
squandered away all the grace of God, ver. 13. And while these continue,
not a serious thought of God can find a place in their minds. And even
when afflictions come upon them, ver. 14, still they will make hard
shifts before they will let the grace of God, concurring with his
providence, persuade them to think of a return, ver. 15, 16. When they
see themselves naked, indigent, and undone, then they recover the
exercise of their reason, ver. 17. Then they remember the blessings they
have thrown away, and attend to the misery they have incurred. And
hereupon they resolve to return to their father, and put the resolution
immediately in practice, ver. 18, 19. Behold with wonder and pleasure
the gracious reception they find from Divine, injured goodness! When
such a prodigal comes to his father, he sees him afar off, ver. 20. He
pities, meets, embraces him, and interrupts his acknowledgments with the
tokens of his returning favour, ver. 21. He arrays him with the robe of
a Redeemer's righteousness, with inward and outward holiness; adorns him
with all his sanctifying graces, and honours him with the tokens of
adopting love, ver. 22. And all this he does with unutterable delight,
in that he who was lost is now found, ver. 23, 24. Let no elder brother
murmur at this indulgence, but rather welcome the prodigal back into the
family. And let those who have been thus received, wander no more, but
emulate the strictest piety of those who for many years have served
their heavenly Father, and not transgressed his commandments.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="6.30%" prev="i.iv.xvi" next="i.iv.xviii" id="i.iv.xvii">
<h3 id="i.iv.xvii-p0.1">XVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XVI" id="i.iv.xvii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.16" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p1">And he said also to his disciples - Not only to the scribes
and Pharisees to whom he had hitherto been speaking, but to all the
younger as well as the elder brethren: to the returning prodigals who
were now his disciples. A certain rich man had a steward - Christ here
teaches all that are now in favour with God, particularly pardoned
penitents, to behave wisely in what is committed to them.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p2">3. To beg I am ashamed - But not ashamed to cheat! This was
likewise a sense of honour! "By men called honour, but by angels
pride."</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p3">4. I know - That is, I am resolved, what to do.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p4">8. And the Lord commended the unjust steward - Namely, in
this respect, because he had used timely precaution: so that though the
dishonesty of such a servant be detestable, yet his foresight, care, and
contrivance, about the interests of this life, deserve our imitation,
with regard to the more important affairs of another. The children of
this world - Those who seek no other portion than this world: Are wiser
- Not absolutely, for they are, one and all, egregious fools; but they
are more consistent with themselves; they are truer to their principles;
they more steadily pursue their end; they are wiser in their generation
- That is, in their own way, than the children of light - The children
of God, whose light shines on their hearts.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p5">9. And I say to you - Be good stewards even of the lowest
talents wherewith God hath intrusted you. Mammon means riches or money.
It is termed the mammon of unrighteousness, because of the manner
wherein it is commonly either procured or employed. Make yourselves
friends of this, by doing all possible good, particularly to the
children of God: that when ye fail, when your flesh and your heart
faileth, when this earthly tabernacle is dissolved, those of them who
have gone before may receive, may welcome you into the everlasting
habitations.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p6">10. And whether ye have more or less, see that ye be
faithful as well as wise stewards. He that is faithful in what is
meanest of all, worldly substance, is also faithful in things of a
higher nature; and he that uses these lowest gifts unfaithfully, is
likewise unfaithful in spiritual things.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p7">11. Who will intrust you with the true riches? - How should
God intrust you with spiritual and eternal, which alone are true
riches?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p8">12. If ye have not been faithful in that which was
another's - None of these temporal things are yours: you are only
stewards of them, not proprietors: God is the proprietor of all; he
lodges them in your hands for a season: but still they are his property.
Rich men, understand and consider this. If your steward uses any part of
your estate (so called in the language of men) any farther or any
otherwise than you direct, he is a knave: he has neither conscience nor
honour. Neither have you either one or the other, if you use any part of
that estate, which is in truth God's, not yours, any otherwise than he
directs. That which is your own - Heaven, which when you have it, will
be your own forever.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p9">13. And you cannot be faithful to God, if you trim between
God and the world, if you do not serve him alone. <scripRef passage="Matt. vi. 24" id="i.iv.xvii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|6|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.6.24">Matt. vi, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p10">15. And he said to them, Ye are they who justify yourselves
before men - The sense of the whole passage is, that pride, wherewith
you justify yourselves, feeds covetousness, derides the Gospel, ver. 14,
and destroys the law, ver. 18. All which is illustrated by a terrible
example. Ye justify yourselves before men - Ye think yourselves
righteous, and persuade others to think you so.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p11">16. The law and the prophets were in force until John: from
that time the Gospel takes place; and humble upright men receive it with
inexpressible earnestness. <scripRef passage="Matt. xi. 13" id="i.iv.xvii-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|11|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.11.13">Matt. xi,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p12">17. Not that the Gospel at all destroys the law. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 18" id="i.iv.xvii-p12.1" parsed="|Matt|5|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.18">Matt. v, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p13">18. But ye do; particularly in this notorious instance. <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 31; xix. 7" id="i.iv.xvii-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|5|31|0|0;|Matt|19|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.31 Bible:Matt.19.7">Matt. v, 31; xix,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p14">19. There was a certain rich man - Very probably a
Pharisee, and one that justified himself before men; a very honest, as
well as honourable gentleman: though it was not proper to mention his
name on this occasion: who was clothed in purple and fine linen - and
doubtless esteemed on this account, (perhaps not only by those who sold
it, but by most that knew him, ) as encouraging trade, and acting
according to his quality: And feasted splendidly every day - And
consequently was esteemed yet more, for his generosity and hospitality
in keeping so good a table.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p15">20. And there was a certain beggar named Lazarus,
(according to the Greek pronunciation) or Eleazer. By his name it may be
conjectured, he was of no mean family, though it was thus reduced. There
was no reason for our Lord to conceal his name, which probably was then
well known. Theophylact observes, from the tradition of the Hebrews,
that he lived at Jerusalem. Yea, the dogs also came and licked his sores
- It seems this circumstance is recorded to show that all his ulcers lay
bare, and were not closed or bound up.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p16">22. And the beggar - Worn out with hunger, and pain, and
want of all things, died: and was carried by angels (amazing change of
the scene!) into Abraham's bosom - So the Jews styled paradise; the
place where the souls of good men remain from death to the resurrection.
The rich man also died, and was buried - Doubtless with pomp enough,
though we do not read of his lying in state; that stupid, senseless
pageantry, that shocking insult on a poor, putrefying carcass, was
reserved for our enlightened age!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p17">23. He seeth Abraham afar off - And yet knew him at that
distance: and shall not Abraham's children, when they are together in
paradise, know each other!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p18">24. Father Abraham, have mercy on me - It cannot be denied,
but here is one precedent in Scripture of praying to departed saints:
but who is it that prays, and with what success? Will any, who considers
this, be fond of copying after him?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p19">25. But Abraham said, Son - According to the flesh. Is it
not worthy of observation, that Abraham will not revile even a damned
soul? and shall living men revile one another? Thou in thy lifetime
receivedst thy good things - Thou didst choose and accept of worldly
things as thy good, thy happiness. And can any be at a loss to know why
he was in torments? This damnable idolatry, had there been nothing more,
was enough to sink him to the nethermost hell.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p20">26. Beside this there is a great gulf fixed - Reader, to
which side of it wilt thou go?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p21">28. Lest they also come into this place - He might justly
fear lest their reproaches should add to his own torment.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xvii-p22">31. Neither will they be persuaded - Truly to repent: for
this implies an entire change of heart: but a thousand apparitions
cannot, effect this. God only can, applying his word.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="6.42%" prev="i.iv.xvii" next="i.iv.xix" id="i.iv.xviii">
<h3 id="i.iv.xviii-p0.1">XVII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XVII" id="i.iv.xviii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p1">1. It is impossible but offenses will come - And they ever
did and do come chiefly by Pharisees, that is, men who trust in
themselves that they are righteous, and despise others. <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 6" id="i.iv.xviii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|18|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.6">Matt. xviii, 6</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 42" id="i.iv.xviii-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|9|42|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.42">Mark ix, 42</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p2">2. Little ones - Weak believers.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p3">3. Take heed to yourselves - That ye neither offend others,
nor be offended by others. <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 15" id="i.iv.xviii-p3.1" parsed="|Matt|18|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.15">Matt.
xviii, 15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p4">4. If he sin against thee seven times in a day, and seven
times in a day return, saying, I repent - That is, if he give sufficient
proof that he does really repent, after having sinned ever so often,
receive him just as if he had never sinned against thee. But this
forgiveness is due only to real penitents. In a lower sense we are to
forgive all, penitent or impenitent; (so as to bear them the sincerest
good will, and to do them all the good we can;) and that not seven times
only, but seventy times seven.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p5">5. Lord, increase our faith - That we may thus forgive, and
may neither offend nor be offended. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 20" id="i.iv.xviii-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|17|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.20">Matt. xvii, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p6">6. And he said, If ye had faith as a grain of mustard seed
- If ye had the least measure of true faith, no instance of duty would
be too hard for you. Ye would say to this sycamine tree - This seems to
have been a kind of proverbial expression.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p7">7. But which of you - But is it not meet that you should
first obey, and then triumph? Though still with a deep sense of your
utter unprofitableness.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p8">9. Doth he thank that servant - Does he account himself
obliged to him?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p9">10. When ye have done all, say, We are unprofitable
servants - For a man cannot profit God. Happy is he who Judges himself
an unprofitable servant: miserable is he whom God pronounces such. But
though we are unprofitable to him, our serving him is not unprofitable
to us. For he is pleased to give by his grace a value to our good works,
which in consequence of his promise entitles us to an eternal
reward.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p10">20. The kingdom of God cometh not with observation - With
such outward pomp as draws the observation of every one.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p11">21. Neither shall they say, Lo here, or lo there - This
shall not be the language of those who are, or shall be sent by me, to
declare the coming of my kingdom. For behold the kingdom of God is
within or among you - Look not for it in distant times or remote places:
it is now in the midst of you: it is come: it is present in the soul of
every true believer: it is a spiritual kingdom, an internal principle.
Wherever it exists, it exists in the heart.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p12">22. Ye shall desire to see one of the days of the Son of
man - One day of mercy or one day wherein you might converse with me,
as you do now.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p13">23. They shall say, See, Christ is here, or there -
Limiting his presence to this or that place. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 23" id="i.iv.xviii-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|24|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.23">Matt. xxiv, 23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p14">24. So shall also the Son of man be - So swift, so wide,
shall his appearing be: In his day - The last day.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p15">26. The days of the Son of man - Those which immediately
follow that which is eminently styled his day. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 37" id="i.iv.xviii-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|24|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.37">Matt. xxiv, 37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p16">31. In that day - (Which will be the grand type of the last
day) when ye shall see Jerusalem encompassed with armies.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p17">32. Remember Lot's wife - And escape with all speed,
without ever looking behind you. <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 24" id="i.iv.xviii-p17.1" parsed="|Luke|9|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.24">Luke
ix, 24</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xii. 25" id="i.iv.xviii-p17.2" parsed="|John|12|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.25">John xii,
25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p18">33. The sense of this and the following verses is, Yet as
great as the danger will be, do not seek to save your life by violating
your conscience: if you do, you will surely lose it: whereas if you
should lose it for my sake, you shall be paid with life everlasting. But
the most probable way of preserving it now, is to be always ready to
give it up: a peculiar Providence shall then watch over you, and put a
difference between you and other men.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xviii-p19">37. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 28" id="i.iv.xviii-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|24|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.28">Matt. xxiv,
28</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="6.48%" prev="i.iv.xviii" next="i.iv.xx" id="i.iv.xix">
<h3 id="i.iv.xix-p0.1">XVIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XVIII" id="i.iv.xix-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.18" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xix-p1">1. He spake a parable to them - This and the following
parable warn us against two fatal extremes, with regard to prayer: the
former against faintness and weariness, the latter against self
confidence.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p2">7. And shall not God - The most just Judge, vindicate his
own elect - Preserve the Christians from all their adversaries, and in
particular save them out of the general destruction, and avenge them of
the Jews? Though he bear long with them - Though he does not immediately
put an end, either to the wrongs of the wicked, or the sufferings of
good men.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p3">8. Yet when the Son of man cometh, will he find faith upon
earth - Yet notwithstanding all the instances both of his long suffering
and of his justice, whenever he shall remarkably appear, against their
enemies in this age or in after ages, how few true believers will be
found upon earth!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p4">9. He spake this parable - Not to hypocrites; the Pharisee
here mentioned was no hypocrite, no more than an outward adulterer: but
he sincerely trusted in himself that he was righteous, and accordingly
told God so, in the prayer which none but God heard.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p5">12. I fast twice in the week - So did all the strict
Pharisees: every Monday and Thursday. I give tithes of all that I
possess - Many of them gave one full tenth of their income in tithes,
and another tenth in alms, the sum of this plea is, I do no harm: I use
all the means of grace: I do all the good I can.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p6">13. The publican standing afar off - From the holy of
holies, would not so much as lift up his eyes to heaven - Touched with
shame, which is more ingenuous than fear.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p7">14. This man went down - From the hill on which the temple
stood, justified rather than the other - That is, and not the other.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p8">15. <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 13" id="i.iv.xix-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|19|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.13">Matt. xix,
13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark x. 13" id="i.iv.xix-p8.2" parsed="|Mark|10|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.13">Mark x, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p9">16. Calling them - Those that brought the children: of such
is the kingdom of God - Such are subjects of the Messiah's kingdom. And
such as these it properly belongs to.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p10">18. <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 16" id="i.iv.xix-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|19|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.16">Matt. xix,
16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark x. 17" id="i.iv.xix-p10.2" parsed="|Mark|10|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.17">Mark x, 17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p11">20. <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 12" id="i.iv.xix-p11.1" parsed="|Exod|20|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.12">Exod. xx,
12</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p12">22. Yet lackest thou one thing - Namely, to love God more
than mammon. Our saviour knew his heart, and presently put him upon a
trial which laid it open to the ruler himself. And to cure his love of
the world, which could not in him be cured otherwise, Christ commanded
him to sell all that he had. But he does not command us to do this; but
to use all to the glory of God.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p13">31. <scripRef passage="Matt. xx. 17" id="i.iv.xix-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|20|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.17">Matt. xx,
17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark x. 32" id="i.iv.xix-p13.2" parsed="|Mark|10|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.32">Mark x, 32</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p14">34. They understood none of these things - The literal
meaning they could not but understand. But as they could not reconcile
this to their preconceived opinion of the Messiah, they were utterly at
a loss in what parabolical or figurative sense to take what he said
concerning his sufferings; having their thoughts still taken up with the
temporal kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xix-p15">35. <scripRef passage="Matt. xx. 29" id="i.iv.xix-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|20|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.29">Matt. xx,
29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark x. 46" id="i.iv.xix-p15.2" parsed="|Mark|10|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.10.46">Mark x, 46</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="6.53%" prev="i.iv.xix" next="i.iv.xxi" id="i.iv.xx">
<h3 id="i.iv.xx-p0.1">XIX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XIX" id="i.iv.xx-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xx-p1">1. He passed through Jericho - So that Zacchaeus must have
lived near the end of the town: the tree was in the town itself. And he
was rich - These words seem to refer to the discourse in the last
chapter, ver. 24, particularly to ver. 27. Zacchiaeus is a proof, that it
is possible by the power of God for even a rich man to enter into the
kingdom of heaven.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p2">2. The chief of the publicans - What we would term,
commissioner of the customs. A very honourable as well as profitable
place.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p3">4. And running before - With great earnestness. He climbed
up - Notwithstanding his quality: desire conquering honour and
shame.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p4">5. Jesus said, Zacchaeus, make haste and come down - What a
strange mixture of passions must Zacchaeus have now felt, hearing one
speak, as knowing both his name and his heart!</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p5">7. They all murmured - All who were near: though most of
them rather out of surprise than indignation.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p6">8. And Zacchaeus stood - Showing by his posture, his
deliberate, purpose and ready mind, and said, Behold, Lord, I give - I
determine to do it immediately.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p7">9. He also is a son of Abraham - A Jew born, and as such
has a right to the first offer of salvation.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p8">10. <scripRef passage="Matt. xviii. 11" id="i.iv.xx-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|18|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.18.11">Matt. xviii,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p9">11. They thought the kingdom of God - A glorious temporal
kingdom, would immediately appear.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p10">12. He went into a far country to receive a kingdom -
Christ went to heaven, to receive his sovereign power as wan, even all
authority in heaven and earth. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxv. 14" id="i.iv.xx-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|25|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.25.14">Matt.
xxv, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 34" id="i.iv.xx-p10.2" parsed="|Mark|13|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.34">Mark xiii,
34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p11">13. Trade till I come - To visit the nation, to destroy
Jerusalem, to judge the world: or, in a more particular sense, to
require thy soul of thee.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p12">14. But his citizens - Such were those of Jerusalem, hated
him, and sent an embassy after him - The word seems to imply, their
sending ambassadors to a superior court, to enter their protest against
his being admitted to the regal power. In such a solemn manner did the
Jews protest, as it were, before God, that Christ should not reign over
them: this man - So they call him in contempt.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p13">15. When he was returned - In his glory.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p14">23. With interest - Which does not appear to be contrary to
any law of God or man. But this is no plea for usury, that is, the
taking such interest as implies any degree of oppression or
extortion.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p15">25. They said - With admiration, not envy.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p16">26. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxv. 29" id="i.iv.xx-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|25|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.25.29">Matt. xxv,
29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke viii. 18" id="i.iv.xx-p16.2" parsed="|Luke|8|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.8.18">Luke viii,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p17">27. He went before - The foremost of the company, showing
his readiness to suffer.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p18">29. He drew nigh to the place where the borders of
Bethphage and Bethany met, which was at the foot of the Mount of Olives.
<scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 1" id="i.iv.xx-p18.1" parsed="|Matt|21|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.1">Matt. xxi, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xi. 1" id="i.iv.xx-p18.2" parsed="|Mark|11|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11.1">Mark xi,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p19">37. The whole multitude began to praise God - Speaking at
once, as it seems, from a Divine impulse, words which most of them did
not understand.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p20">38. Peace in heaven - God being reconciled to man.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p21">39. Rebuke thy disciples - Paying thee this immoderate
honour.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p22">40. If these should hold their peace, the stones, which lie
before you, would cry out - That is, God would raise up some still more
unlikely instruments to declare his praise. For the power of God will
not return empty.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p23">42. O that thou hadst known, at least in this thy day -
After thou hast neglected so many. Thy day - The day wherein God still
offers thee his blessings.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p24">43. Thine enemies shall cast a trench about thee, and
compass thee around - All this was exactly performed by Titus, the Roman
general.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p25">44. And thy children within thee - All the Jews were at
that time gathered together, it being the time of the passover. They
shall not leave in thee one stone upon another - Only three towers were
left standing for a time, to show the former strength and magnificence
of the place. But these likewise were afterward levelled with the
ground.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p26">45. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 12" id="i.iv.xx-p26.1" parsed="|Matt|21|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.12">Matt. xxi,
12</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xi. 11" id="i.iv.xx-p26.2" parsed="|Mark|11|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11.11">Mark xi,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xx-p27">46. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lvi. 7" id="i.iv.xx-p27.1" parsed="|Isa|56|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.56.7">Isaiah lvi,
7</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="6.60%" prev="i.iv.xx" next="i.iv.xxii" id="i.iv.xxi">
<h3 id="i.iv.xxi-p0.1">XX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XX" id="i.iv.xxi-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.20" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 23" id="i.iv.xxi-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|21|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.23">Matt. xxi,
23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xi. 27" id="i.iv.xxi-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|11|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11.27">Mark xi,
27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p2">9. A long time - It was a long time from the entrance of
the Israelites into Canaan to the birth of Christ. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 33" id="i.iv.xxi-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|21|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.33">Matt. xxi, 33</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 1" id="i.iv.xxi-p2.2" parsed="|Mark|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.1">Mark xii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p3">16. He will destroy these husbandmen - Probably he pointed
to the scribes, chief priests, and elders: who allowed, he will
miserably destroy those wicked men, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 41" id="i.iv.xxi-p3.1" parsed="|Matt|21|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.41">Matt. xxi, 41</scripRef>; but could not bear that this should be applied to
themselves. They might also mean, God forbid that we should be guilty of
such a crime as your parable seems to charge us with, namely, rejecting
and killing the heir. Our saviour answers, But yet will ye do it, as is
prophesied of you.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p4">17. He looked on them - To sharpen their attention. <scripRef passage="Psalm cxviii. 22" id="i.iv.xxi-p4.1" parsed="|Ps|118|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.118.22">Psalm cxviii, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p5">18. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 45" id="i.iv.xxi-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|21|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.45">Matt. xxi,
45</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p6">20. Just men - Men of a tender conscience. To take hold of
his discourse - If he answered as they hoped he would. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxii. 16" id="i.iv.xxi-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|22|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.22.16">Matt. xxii, 16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 12" id="i.iv.xxi-p6.2" parsed="|Mark|12|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.12">Mark xii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p7">21. Thou speakest - In private, and teachest - In
public.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p8">24. Show me a penny - A Roman penny, which was the money
that was usually paid on that occasion.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p9">26. They could not take hold of his words before the people
- As they did afterward before the sanhedrim, in the absence of the
people, chap. xxii, 67.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p10">27. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxii. 23" id="i.iv.xxi-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|22|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.22.23">Matt. xxii,
23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 18" id="i.iv.xxi-p10.2" parsed="|Mark|12|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.18">Mark xii,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p11">28. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 5" id="i.iv.xxi-p11.1" parsed="|Deut|25|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.5">Deut. xxv,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p12">34. The children of this world - The inhabitants of earth,
marry and are given in marriage - As being all subject to the law of
mortality; so that the species is in need of being continually
repaired.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p13">35. But they who obtain that world - Which they enter into,
before the resurrection of the dead.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p14">36. They are the children of God - In a more eminent sense
when they rise again.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p15">37. That the dead are raised, even Moses, as well as the
other prophets showed, when he calleth - That is, when he recites the
words which God spoke of himself, I am the God of Abraham, &amp;c. It
cannot properly be said, that God is the God of any who are totally
perished. <scripRef passage="Exod. iii. 6" id="i.iv.xxi-p15.1" parsed="|Exod|3|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3.6">Exod. iii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p16">38. He is not a God of the dead, or, there is no God of the
dead - That is, tho term God implies such a relation, as cannot possibly
subsist between him and the dead; who in the Sadducees' sense are
extinguished spirits; who could neither worship him, nor receive good
from him. So that all live to him - All who have him for their God, live
to and enjoy him. This sentence is not an argument for what went before;
but the proposition which was to be proved. And the consequence is
apparently just. For as all the faithful are the children of Abraham,
and the Divine promise of being a God to him and his seed is entailed
upon them, it implies their continued existence and happiness in a
future state as much as Abraham's. And as the body is an essential part
of man, it implies both his resurrection and theirs; and so overthrows
the entire scheme of the Sadducean doctrine.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p17">40. They durst not ask him any question - The Sadducees
durst not. One of the scribes did, presently after.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p18">41. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxii. 41" id="i.iv.xxi-p18.1" parsed="|Matt|22|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.22.41">Matt. xxii,
41</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 35" id="i.iv.xxi-p18.2" parsed="|Mark|12|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.35">Mark xii,
35</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p19">42. <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 1" id="i.iv.xxi-p19.1" parsed="|Ps|110|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.1">Psalm cx,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p20">46. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 5" id="i.iv.xxi-p20.1" parsed="|Matt|23|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.5">Matt. xxiii,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxi-p21">47. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 14" id="i.iv.xxi-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|23|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.14">Matt. xxiii,
14</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="6.65%" prev="i.iv.xxi" next="i.iv.xxiii" id="i.iv.xxii">
<h3 id="i.iv.xxii-p0.1">XXI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XXI" id="i.iv.xxii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p1">1. He looked up - From those on whom his eyes were fixed
before. <scripRef passage="Mark xii. 41" id="i.iv.xxii-p1.1" parsed="|Mark|12|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.12.41">Mark xii, 41</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p2">5. Goodly stones - Such as no engines now in use could have
brought, or even set upon each other. Some of them (as an eye witness
who lately measured them writes) were forty - five cubits long, five
high, and six broad; yet brought thither from another country. And gifts
- Which persons delivered from imminent dangers had, in accomplishment
of their vows, hung on the walls and pillars. The marble of the temple
was so white, that it appeared like a mountain of snow at a distance.
And the gilding of many parts made it, especially when the sun shone, a
most splendid and beautiful spectacle. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 1" id="i.iv.xxii-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.1">Matt. xxiv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 1" id="i.iv.xxii-p2.2" parsed="|Mark|13|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.1">Mark xiii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p3">8. I am the Christ; and the time is near - When I will
deliver you from all your enemies. They are the words of the
seducers.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p4">9. Commotions - Intestine broils; civil wars.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p5">11. Fearful sights and signs from heaven - Of which
Josephus gives a circumstantial account.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p6">12. <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 9" id="i.iv.xxii-p6.1" parsed="|Mark|13|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.9">Mark xiii,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p7">13. It shall turn to you for a testimony - Of your having
delivered your own souls, and of their being without excuse.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p8">16. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 21" id="i.iv.xxii-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|10|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.21">Matt. x,
21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p9">17. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 13" id="i.iv.xxii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|24|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.13">Matt. xxiv,
13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 13" id="i.iv.xxii-p9.2" parsed="|Mark|13|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.13">Mark xiii,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p10">18. Not a hair of your head - A proverbial expression,
shall perish - Without the special providence of God. And then, not
before the time, nor without a full reward.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p11">19. In your patience possess ye your souls - Be calm and
serene, masters of yourselves, and superior to all irrational and
disquieting passions. By keeping the government of your spirits, you
will both avoid much misery, and guard the better against all
dangers.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p12">21. Let them that are in the midst of it - Where Jerusalem
stands (that is, they that are in Jerusalem) depart out of it, before
their retreat is cut off by the uniting of the forces near the city, and
let not them that are in the adjacent countries by any means enter into
it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p13">22. And things which are written - Particularly in
Daniel.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p14">24. They shall fall by the edge of the sword, and shall be
led away captive - Eleven hundred thousand perished in the siege of
Jerusalem, and above ninety thousand were sold for slaves. So terribly
was this prophecy fulfilled! And Jerusalem shall be trodden by the
Gentiles - That is, inhabited. So it was indeed. The land was sold, and
no Jew suffered even to come within sight of Jerusalem. The very
foundations of the city were ploughed up, and a heathen temple built
where the temple of God had stood. The times of the Gentiles - That is,
the times limited for their treading the city; which shall terminate in
the full conversion of the Gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p15">25. And there shall be - Before the great day, which was
typified by the destruction of Jerusalem: signs - Different from those
mentioned in ver. 11. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 29" id="i.iv.xxii-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|24|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.29">Matt. xxiv,
29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 24" id="i.iv.xxii-p15.2" parsed="|Mark|13|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.24">Mark xiii,
24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p16">28. Now when these things - Mentioned ver. 8, 10, &amp;c.,
begin to come to pass, look up with firm faith, and lift up your heads
with joy: for your redemption out of many troubles draweth nigh, by
God's destroying your implacable enemies.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p17">29. Behold the fig tree and all the trees - Christ spake
this in the spring, just before the passover; when all the trees were
budding on the Mount of Olives, where they then were.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p18">30. Ye know of yourselves - Though none teach you.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p19">31. The kingdom of God is nigh - The destruction of the
Jewish city, temple, and religion, to make way for the advancement of my
kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p20">32. Till all things be effected - All that has been spoken
of the destruction of Jerusalem, to which the question, ver. 7, relates:
and which is treated of from ver. 8-24.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p21">34. Take heed, lest at any time your hearts be overloaded
with gluttony and drunkenness - And was there need to warn the apostles
themselves against such sins as these? Then surely there is reason to
warn even strong Christians against the very grossest sins. Neither are
we wise, if we think ourselves out of the reach of any sin: and so that
day - Of judgment or of death, come upon you, even you that are not of
this world-Unawares. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 42" id="i.iv.xxii-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|24|42|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.42">Matt. xxiv,
42</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiii. 33" id="i.iv.xxii-p21.2" parsed="|Mark|13|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.13.33">Mark xiii,
33</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 35" id="i.iv.xxii-p21.3" parsed="|Luke|12|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.35">Luke xii,
35</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p22">35. That sit - Careless and at ease.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p23">36. Watch ye therefore - This is the general conclusion of
all that precedes. That ye may be counted worthy - This word sometimes
signifies an honour conferred on a person, as when the apostles are said
to be counted worthy to suffer shame for Christ, <scripRef passage="Acts v. 41" id="i.iv.xxii-p23.1" parsed="|Acts|5|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.5.41">Acts v, 41</scripRef>. Sometimes meet or becoming: as when John the Baptist
exhorts, to bring fruits worthy of repentance, chap. iii, 8. And so to
be counted worthy to escape, is to have the honour of it, and to be
fitted or prepared for it. To stand - With joy and triumph: not to fall
before him as his enemies.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p24">37. Now by day - In the day time, he was teaching in the
temple - This shows how our Lord employed his time after coming to
Jerusalem: but it is not said, he was this day in the temple, and next
morning the people came. It does not therefore by any means imply, that
he came any more after this into the temple.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxii-p25">38. And all the people came early in the morning to hear
him - How much happier were his disciples in these early lectures, than
the slumbers of the morning could have made them on their beds! Let us
not scruple to deny ourselves the indulgence of unnecessary sleep, that
we may morning after morning place ourselves at his feet, receiving the
instructions of his word, and seeking those of his Spirit.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="6.74%" prev="i.iv.xxii" next="i.iv.xxiv" id="i.iv.xxiii">
<h3 id="i.iv.xxiii-p0.1">XXII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XXII" id="i.iv.xxiii-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 1" id="i.iv.xxiii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|26|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.1">Matt. xxvi,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 1" id="i.iv.xxiii-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.1">Mark xiv,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p2">3. Then entered Satan - Who is never wanting to assist
those whose heart is bent upon mischief.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p3">4. Captains - Called captains of the temple, ver. 52. They
were Jewish officers, who presided over the guards which kept watch
every night in the temple.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p4">7. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 17" id="i.iv.xxiii-p4.1" parsed="|Matt|26|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.17">Matt. xxvi,
17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 12" id="i.iv.xxiii-p4.2" parsed="|Mark|14|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.12">Mark xiv,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p5">14. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 20" id="i.iv.xxiii-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|26|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.20">Matt. xxvi,
20</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 17" id="i.iv.xxiii-p5.2" parsed="|Mark|14|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.17">Mark xiv,
17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p6">15. With desire have I desired - That is, I have earnestly
desired it. He desired it, both for the sake of his disciples, to whom
he desired to manifest himself farther, at this solemn parting: and for
the sake of his whole Church, that he might institute the grand memorial
of his death.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p7">16. For I will not eat thereof any more - That is, it will
be the last I shall eat with you before I die. The kingdom of God did
not properly commence till his resurrection. Then was fulfilled what was
typified by the passover.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p8">17. And he took the cup - That cup which used to be brought
at the beginning of the paschal solemnity, and said, Take this and
divide it among yourselves; for I will not drink - As if he had said, Do
not expect me to drink of it: I will drink no more before I die.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p9">19. And he took bread - Namely, some time after, when
supper was ended, wherein they had eaten the paschal lamb. This is my
body - As he had just now celebrated the paschal supper, which was
called the passover, so in like figurative language, he calls this bread
his body. And this circumstance of itself was sufficient to prevent any
mistake, as if this bread was his real body, any more than the paschal
lamb was really the passover.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p10">20. This cup is the New Testament - Here is an undeniable
figure, whereby the cup is put for the wine in the cup. And this is
called, The New Testament in Christ's blood, which could not possibly
mean, that it was the New Testament itself, but only the seal of it, and
the sign of that blood which was shed to confirm it.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p11">21. The hand of him that betrayeth me is with me on the
table - It is evident Christ spake these words before he instituted the
Lord's Supper: for all the other evangelists mention the sop,
immediately after receiving which he went out: <scripRef passage="John xiii. 30" id="i.iv.xxiii-p11.1" parsed="|John|13|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.13.30">John xiii, 30</scripRef>. Nor did he return any more, till he came into the garden to
betray his Master. Now this could not be dipped or given, but while the
meat was on the table. But this was all removed before that bread and
cup were brought.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p12">24. There was also a contention among them - It is highly
probable, this was the same dispute which is mentioned by St. Matthew
and St. Mark: and consequently, though it is related here, it happened
some time before.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p13">25. They that exercise the most arbitrary authority over
them, have from their flatterers the vain title of benefactors.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p14">26. But ye are to be benefactors to mankind, not by
governing, but by serving.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p15">27. For - This he proves by his own example. I am in the
midst of you - Just now: see with your eyes. I take no state upon me,
but sit in the midst, on a level with the lowest of you.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p16">28. Ye have continued with me in my temptations - And all
his life was nothing else, particularly from his entering on his public
ministry.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p17">29. And I - Will preserve you in all your temptations, till
ye enter into the kingdom of glory: appoint to you - By these very
words. Not a primacy to one, but a kingdom to every one: on the same
terms: as my Father hath appointed to me - Who have fought and
conquered.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p18">30. That ye may eat and drink at my table - That is, that
ye may enjoy the highest happiness, as guests, not as servants. These
expressions seem to be primarily applicable to the twelve apostles, and
secondarily, to all Christ's servants and disciples, whose spiritual
powers, honours, and delights, are here represented in figurative terms,
with respect to their advancement both in the kingdom of grace and of
glory.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p19">31. Satan hath desired to have you - My apostles, that he
might sift you as wheat - Try you to the uttermost.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p20">32. But I have prayed for thee - Who wilt be in the
greatest danger of all: that thy faith fail not - Altogether: and when
thou art returned - From thy flight, strengthen thy brethren -- all that
are weak in faith; perhaps scandalized at thy fall.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p21">34. It shall not be the time of cock crowing this day - The
common time of cock crowing (which is usually about three in the
morning) probably did not come till after the cock which Peter heard had
crowed twice, if not oftener.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p22">35. When I sent you - lacked ye any thing - Were ye not
born above all want and danger?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p23">36. But now - You will be quite in another situation. You
will want every thing. He that hath no sword, let him sell his garment
and buy one - It is plain, this is not to be taken literally. It only
means, This will be a time of extreme danger.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p24">37. The things which are written concerning me have an end
- Are now drawing to a period; are upon the point of being accomplished.
<scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 12" id="i.iv.xxiii-p24.1" parsed="|Isa|53|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.12">Isaiah liii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p25">38. Here are two swords - Many of Galilee carried them when
they travelled, to defend themselves against robbers and assassins, who
much infested their roads. But did the apostles need to seek such
defense? And he said; It is enough - I did not mean literally, that
every one of you must have a sword.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p26">39. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 30" id="i.iv.xxiii-p26.1" parsed="|Matt|26|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.30">Matt. xxvi,
30</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p27">40. The place - The garden of Gethsemane.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p28">43. Strengthening him - Lest his body should sink and die
before the time.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p29">44. And being in an agony - Probably just now grappling
with the powers of darkness: feeling the weight of the wrath of God, and
at the same time surrounded with a mighty host of devils, who exercised
all their force and malice to persecute and distract his wounded spirit.
He prayed more earnestly - Even with stronger cries and tars: and his
sweat - As cold as the weather was, was as it were great drops of blood
- Which, by the vehement distress of his soul, were forced out of the
pores, in so great a quantity as afterward united in large, thick,
grumous drops, and even fell to the ground.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p30">48. Betrayest thou the Son of man - He whom thou knowest to
be the Son of man, the Christ?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p31">49. Seeing what would follow - That they were just going to
seize him. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 51" id="i.iv.xxiii-p31.1" parsed="|Matt|26|51|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.51">Matt. xxvi, 51</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 47" id="i.iv.xxiii-p31.2" parsed="|Mark|14|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.47">Mark xiv, 47</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p32">51. Suffer me at least to have my hands at liberty thus
far, while I do one more act of mercy.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p33">52. Jesus said to the chief priests, and captains, and the
elders who were come - And all these came of their own accord: the
soldiers and servants were sent.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p34">53. This is your hour - Before which ye could not take me:
and the power of darkness - The time when Satan has power.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p35">54. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 57" id="i.iv.xxiii-p35.1" parsed="|Matt|26|57|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.57">Matt. xxvi,
57</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 53" id="i.iv.xxiii-p35.2" parsed="|Mark|14|53|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.53">Mark xiv, 53</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 12" id="i.iv.xxiii-p35.3" parsed="|John|18|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.12">John xviii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p36">58. Another man saw him and said - Observe here, in order
to reconcile the four evangelists, that divers persons concurred in
charging Peter with belonging to Christ.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.xxiii-p37">1. The maid that led him in, afterward seeing
him at the fire, first put the question to him, and then positively
affirmed, that he was with Christ.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.xxiii-p38">2. Another maid accused him to the standers
by, and gave occasion to the man here mentioned, to renew the charge
against him, which caused the second denial.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.iv.xxiii-p39">3. Others of the company took notice of his
being a Galilean, and were seconded by the kinsman of Malchus, who
affirmed he had seen him in the garden. And this drew on the third
denial.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p40">59. And about one hour after - So he did not recollect
himself in all that time.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p41">63. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 67" id="i.iv.xxiii-p41.1" parsed="|Matt|26|67|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.67">Matt. xxvi,
67</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 65" id="i.iv.xxiii-p41.2" parsed="|Mark|14|65|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.65">Mark xiv,
65</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p42">64. And having blindfolded him, they struck him on the face
- This is placed by St. Matthew and Mark, after the council's condemning
him. Probably he was abused in the same manner, both before and after
his condemnation.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p43">65. Many other things blasphemously spake they against him
- The expression is remarkable. They charged him with blasphemy, because
he said he was the Son of God: but the evangelist fixes that charge on
them, because he really was so.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p44">66. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 63" id="i.iv.xxiii-p44.1" parsed="|Matt|26|63|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.63">Matt. xxvi,
63</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 61" id="i.iv.xxiii-p44.2" parsed="|Mark|14|61|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.61">Mark xiv,
61</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiii-p45">70. They all said, Art thou then the Son of God? - Both
these, the Son of God, and the Son of man, were known titles of the
Messiah; the one taken from his Divine, and the other from his human
nature.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="6.89%" prev="i.iv.xxiii" next="i.iv.xxv" id="i.iv.xxiv">
<h3 id="i.iv.xxiv-p0.1">XXIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XXIII" id="i.iv.xxiv-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 1" id="i.iv.xxiv-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|27|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.1">Matt. xxvii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 1" id="i.iv.xxiv-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|15|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.1">Mark xv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 28" id="i.iv.xxiv-p1.3" parsed="|John|18|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.28">John xviii, 28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p2">4. Then said Pilate - After having heard his defense-I find
no fault in this man - I do not find that he either asserts or attempts
any thing seditious or injurious to Caesar.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p3">5. He stirreth up the people, beginning from Galilee -
Probably they mentioned Galilee to alarm Pilate, because the Galileans
were notorious for sedition and rebellion.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p4">7. He sent him to Herod - As his proper judge.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p5">8. He had been long desirous to see him - Out of mere
curiosity.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p6">9. He questioned him - Probably concerning the miracles
which were reported to have been wrought by him.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p7">11. Herod set him at nought - Probably judging him to be a
fool, because he answered nothing. In a splendid robe - In royal
apparel; intimating that he feared nothing from this king.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p8">15. He hath done nothing worthy of death - According to the
judgment of Herod also.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p9">16. I will therefore chastise him - Here Pilate began to
give ground, which only encouraged them to press on. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 15" id="i.iv.xxiv-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|27|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.15">Matt. xxvii, 15</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 6" id="i.iv.xxiv-p9.2" parsed="|Mark|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.6">Mark xv, 6</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xviii. 39" id="i.iv.xxiv-p9.3" parsed="|John|18|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.39">John xviii, 39</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p10">22. He said to them the third time, Why, what evil hath he
done? - As Peter, a disciple of Christ, dishonoured him by denying him
thrice, so Pilate, a heathen, honoured Christ, by thrice owning him to
be innocent.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p11">26. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 31" id="i.iv.xxiv-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|27|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.31">Matt. xxvii,
31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 21" id="i.iv.xxiv-p11.2" parsed="|Mark|15|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.21">Mark xv, 21</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 16" id="i.iv.xxiv-p11.3" parsed="|John|19|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.16">John xix, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p12">30. <scripRef passage="Hosea x. 8" id="i.iv.xxiv-p12.1" parsed="|Hos|10|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.10.8">Hosea x,
8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p13">31. If they do these things in the green tree, what shall
be done in the dry? - Our Lord makes use of a proverbial expression,
frequent among the Jews, who compare a good man to a green tree, and a
bad man to a dead one: as if he had said, If an innocent person suffer
thus, what will become of the wicked? Of those who are as ready for
destruction as dry wood for the fire?</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p14">34. Then said Jesus - Our Lord passed most of the time on
the cross in silence: yet seven sentences which he spoke thereon are
recorded by the four evangelists, though no one evangelist has recorded
them all. Hence it appears that the four Gospels are, as it were, four
parts, which, joined together, make one symphony. Sometimes one of these
only, sometimes two or three, sometimes all sound together. Father - So
he speaks both in the beginning and at the end of his sufferings on the
cross: Forgive them - How striking is this passage! While they are
actually nailing him to the cross, he seems to feel the injury they did
to their own souls more than the wounds they gave him; and as it were to
forget his own anguish out of a concern for their own salvation. And how
eminently was his prayer heard! It procured forgiveness for all that
were penitent, and a suspension of vengeance even for the
impenitent.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p15">35. If thou be the Christ; ver. 37. If thou be the king -
The priests deride the name of Messiah: the soldiers the name of
king.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p16">38. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 37" id="i.iv.xxiv-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|27|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.37">Matt. xxvii,
37</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 26" id="i.iv.xxiv-p16.2" parsed="|Mark|15|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.26">Mark xv, 26</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 19" id="i.iv.xxiv-p16.3" parsed="|John|19|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.19">John xix, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p17">39. And one of the malefactors reviled him - St. Matthew
says, the robbers: St. Mark, they that were crucified with him, reviled
him. Either therefore St. Matthew and Mark put the plural for the
singular (as the best authors sometimes do) or both reviled him at the
first, till one of them felt "the overwhelming power of saving
grace."</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p18">40. The other rebuked him - What a surprising degree was
here of repentance, faith, and other graces! And what abundance of good
works, in his public confession of his sin, reproof of his fellow
criminal, his honourable testimony to Christ, and profession of faith in
him, while he was in so disgraceful circumstances as were stumbling even
to his disciples! This shows the power of Divine grace. But it
encourages none to put off their repentance to the last hour; since, as
far as appears, this was the first time this criminal had an opportunity
of knowing any thing of Christ, and his conversion was designed to put a
peculiar glory on our saviour in his lowest state, while his enemies
derided him, and his own disciples either denied or forsook him.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p19">42. Remember me when thou comest - From heaven, in thy
kingdom - He acknowledges him a king, and such a king, as after he is
dead, can profit the dead. The apostles themselves had not then so clear
conceptions of the kingdom of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p20">43. In paradise - The place where the souls of the
righteous remain from death till the resurrection. As if he had said, I
will not only remember thee then, but this very day.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p21">44. There was darkness over all the earth - The noon-tide
darkness, covering the sun, obscured all the upper hemisphere. And the
lower was equally darkened, the moon being in opposition to the sun, and
so receiving no light from it. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 45" id="i.iv.xxiv-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|27|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.45">Matt. xxvii, 45</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p22">45. <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 38" id="i.iv.xxiv-p22.1" parsed="|Mark|15|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.38">Mark xv,
38</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p23">46. Father, into thy hands - The Father receives the Spirit
of Jesus: Jesus himself the spirits of the faithful.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p24">47. Certainly this was a righteous man - Which implies an
approbation of all he had done and taught.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p25">48. All the people - Who had not been actors therein,
returned smiting their breasts - In testimony of sorrow.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxiv-p26">50. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 57" id="i.iv.xxiv-p26.1" parsed="|Matt|27|57|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.57">Matt. xxvii,
57</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 43" id="i.iv.xxiv-p26.2" parsed="|Mark|15|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.43">Mark xv, 43</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xix. 38" id="i.iv.xxiv-p26.3" parsed="|John|19|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.38">John xix, 38</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="6.97%" prev="i.iv.xxiv" next="i.v" id="i.iv.xxv">
<h3 id="i.iv.xxv-p0.1">XXIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Luke XXIV" id="i.iv.xxv-p0.2" parsed="|Luke|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24" /> 

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p1">1. Certain others with them - Who had not come from
Galilee. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxviii. 1" id="i.iv.xxv-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|28|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.28.1">Matt. xxviii, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xvi. 1" id="i.iv.xxv-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|16|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.16.1">Mark xvi, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xx. 1" id="i.iv.xxv-p1.3" parsed="|John|20|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.1">John xx, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p2">4. Behold two - Angels in the form of men. Mary had seen
them a little before. They had disappeared on these women's coming to
the sepulchre, but now appeared again. St. Matthew and Mark mention only
one of them, appearing like a young man.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p3">6. Remember how he spake to you, saying, The Son of man
must be delivered - This is only a repetition of the words which our
Lord had spoken to them before his passion But it is observable, he
never styles himself the Son of man after his resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p4">13. <scripRef passage="Mark xvi. 12" id="i.iv.xxv-p4.1" parsed="|Mark|16|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.16.12">Mark xvi,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p5">21. Today is the third day - The day he should have risen
again, if at all.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p6">25. O foolish - Not understanding the designs and works of
God: And slow of heart - Unready to believe what the prophets have so
largely spoken.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p7">26. Ought not Christ - If he would redeem man, and fulfil
the prophecies concerning him, to have suffered these things? - These
very sufferings which occasion your doubts, are the proofs of his being
the Messiah. And to enter into his glory - Which could be done no other
way.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p8">28. He made as though he would go farther - Walking
forward, as if he was going on; and he would have done it, had they not
pressed him to stay.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p9">29. They constrained him - By their importunate
entreaties.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p10">30. He took the bread, and blessed, and brake - Just in the
same manner as when he instituted his last supper.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p11">31. Their eyes were opened - That is, the supernatural
cloud was removed: And he vanished - Went away insensibly.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p12">32. Did not our heart burn within us - Did not we feel an
unusual warmth of love! Was not our heart burning, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p13">33. The same hour - Late as it was.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p14">34. The Lord hath appeared to Simon - Before he was seen of
the twelve apostles, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. xv. 5" id="i.iv.xxv-p14.1" parsed="|1Cor|15|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.15.5">1 Cor. xv,
5</scripRef>. He had, in his wonderful condescension and grace, taken an
opportunity on the former part of that day (though where, or in what
manner, is not recorded) to show himself to Peter, that he might early
relieve his distresses and fears, on account of having so shamefully
denied his Master.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p15">35. In the breaking of bread - The Lord's Supper.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p16">36. Jesus stood in the midst of them - It was just as easy
to his Divine power to open a door undiscernibly, as it was to come in
at a door opened by some other hand. <scripRef passage="Mark xvi. 14, 19" id="i.iv.xxv-p16.1" parsed="|Mark|16|14|0|0;|Mark|16|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.16.14 Bible:Mark.16.19">Mark xvi, 14, 19</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xx. 19" id="i.iv.xxv-p16.2" parsed="|John|20|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.19">John xx, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p17">40. He showed them his hands and his feet - That they might
either see or feel the prints of the nails.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p18">41. While they believed not for joy - They did in some
sense believe: otherwise they would not have rejoiced. But their excess
of joy prevented a clear, rational belief.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p19">43. He took it and ate before them - Not that he had any
need of food; but to give them still further evidence.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p20">44. And he said - On the day of his ascension. In the law,
and the prophets, and the Psalms - The prophecies as well as types,
relating to the Messiah, are contained either in the books of Moses
(usually called the law) in the Psalms, or in the writings of the
prophets; little being said directly concerning him in the historical
books.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p21">45. Then opened he their understanding, to understand the
Scriptures - He had explained them before to the two as they went to
Emmaus. But still they understood them not, till he took off the veil
from their hearts, by the illumination of his Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p22">47. Beginning at Jerusalem - This was appointed most
graciously and wisely: graciously, as it encouraged the, greatest
sinners to repent, when they saw that even the murderers of Christ were
not excepted from mercy: and wisely, as hereby Christianity was more
abundantly attested; the facts being published first on the very spot
where they happened.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p23">49. Behold I send the promise - Emphatically so called; the
Holy Ghost.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p24">50. He led them out as far as Bethany - Not the town, but
the district: to the Mount of Olives, <scripRef passage="Acts i. 12" id="i.iv.xxv-p24.1" parsed="|Acts|1|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1.12">Acts i, 12</scripRef>, which stood within the boundaries of Bethany.</p>

<p id="i.iv.xxv-p25">51. And while he was blessing them, he was parted from them
- It was much more proper that our Lord should ascend into heaven, than
that he should rise from the dead, in the sight of the apostles. For his
resurrection was proved when they saw him alive after his passion: but
they could not see him in heaven while they continued on earth. Please
see Notes at <scripRef passage="Matt. i. 1" id="i.iv.xxv-p25.1" parsed="|Matt|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.1.1">Matt. i, 1</scripRef></p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE GOSPEL ACCORDING TO ST. JOHN" progress="7.05%" prev="i.iv.xxv" next="i.v.i" id="i.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John" id="i.v-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.v-p0.2">NOTES ON THE GOSPEL ACCORDING TO ST. JOHN</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to John" progress="7.05%" prev="i.v" next="i.v.ii" id="i.v.i">

<p id="i.v.i-p1">In this book is set down the history of the Son of God
dwelling among men; that,</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.v.i-p2">I. Of the first days, where the apostle,
premising the sum of the whole Chap. i, 1-14 Mentions the testimony
given by John, after the baptism of Christ, and the first calling of
some of the apostles. Here is noted what fell out,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p3">The first day 15-28</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p4">The day after 29-34</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p5">The day after 35-42</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p6">The day after 43-52</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p7">The third day ii, 1-11</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p8">After this 12</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.v.i-p9">II. Of the two years between, spent chiefly
in journeys to and from Jerusalem,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p10">A. The first journey, to the passover 13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p11">a. Transactions in the city,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p12">1. Zeal for his Father's house 14-22</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p13">2. The power and wisdom of Jesus 23-25</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p14">3. The instruction of Nicodemus iii, 1-21</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p15">b. His abode in Judea; the rest of John's
testimony 22-36</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p16">c. His journey through Samaria (where he
confers with the Samaritan woman) into Galilee, where he heals the
nobleman's son iv, 1-54</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p17">B. The second journey to the feast of
pentecost. Here may be observed transactions,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p18">a. In the city, relating to the impotent man,
healed at the pool of Bethesda v, 1-47</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p19">b. In Galilee, before the second passover and
after. Here we may note,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p20">1. His feeding the five thousand vi, 1-14</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p21">2. Walking upon the sea 15-21</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p22">3. Discourse of himself, as the bread of life
22-59</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p23">4. Reproof of those who objected to it
60-65</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p24">5. Apostasy of many, and steadiness of the
apostles 66-71</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p25">6. His continuance in Galilee ` vii, 1</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p26">C. The third journey, to the feast of
tabernacles 2-13 Here may be observed transactions,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p27">a. In the city,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p28">1. In the middle and end of the feast 14-53
viii; Where note,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p29">1. The woman taken in adultery 2-12</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p30">2. Christ's preaching and vindicating his
doctrine 13-30</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p31">3. His confuting the Jews and escape from
them 31-59</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p32">4. His healing the man born blind ix, 1-7</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p33">5. Several discourses on that occasion
8-41</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p34">6. Christ the Door and the Shepherd of the
sheep, 1-18</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p35">7. Different opinions concerning him
19-21</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p36">2. At the feast of the dedication. here
occur,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p37">1. His disputes with the Jews Chap. x,
22-38</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p38">2. His escaping their fury 39</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p39">b. Beyond Jordan 40-42</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.v.i-p40">III. Of the last days, which were,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p41">A. Before the great week, where we may
note,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p42">a. The two days spent out of Judea, while
Lazarus was sick and died xi, 1-6</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p43">b. The journey into Judea; the raising of
Lazarus; the advice of Caiaphas; Jesus's abode in Ephraim; the order
given by his adversaries 7-57</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p44">c. The sixth day, before the passover; the
supper at Bethany; the ointment poured on Jesus xii, 1-11</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p45">B. In the great week, wherein was the third
passover, occur,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p46">a. On the three former days, his royal entry
into the city; the desire of the Greeks; the obstinacy of the Jews; the
testimony given to Jesus from heaven 12-50</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p47">b. On the fourth day, the washing the feet of
the disciples; the discovery of the traitor, and his going out by night
xiii, 1-30</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p48">c. On the fifth day,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p49">1. His discourse</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p50">1. Before the paschal supper 31, xiv,
1-31</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p51">2. After it xv, and xvi.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p52">2. His prayer xvii, 1-26</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p53">3. The beginning of his passion,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p54">1. In the garden xviii, 1-11</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p55">2. In Caiaphas's house 12-27</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p56">d. On the sixth day,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p57">1. His passion under Pilate,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p58">1. In the palace of Pilate 28 xix, 1-16</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.v.i-p59">2. On the cross 17-30</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p60">2. His death 30-37</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p61">3. His burial 38-42</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.v.i-p62">C. After the great week,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p63">a. On the day of the resurrection xx,
1-25</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p64">b. Eight days after 26-31</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.i-p65">c. After that</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p66">1. He appears to his disciples at the sea of
Tiberias. xxi, 1-14</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p67">2. Orders Peter to feed his sheep and lambs
15-17</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p68">3. Foretells the manner of Peter's death, and
checks his curiosity about St <scripRef passage="John 18" id="i.v.i-p68.1" parsed="|John|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18">John 18</scripRef>-23</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.i-p69">4. The conclusion 24, 25</p>
<h2 id="i.v.i-p69.1">THE GOSPEL OF JOHN</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="7.11%" prev="i.v.i" next="i.v.iii" id="i.v.ii">
<h3 id="i.v.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John I" id="i.v.ii-p0.2" parsed="|John|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1" /> 

<p id="i.v.ii-p1">1. In the beginning - (Referring to <scripRef passage="Gen. i. 1" id="i.v.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.1.1">Gen. i, 1</scripRef>, and <scripRef passage="Prov. viii. 23" id="i.v.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Prov|8|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.8.23">Prov. viii, 23</scripRef>.) When all things began to be made by the Word: in the
beginning of heaven and earth, and this whole frame of created beings,
the Word existed, without any beginning. He was when all things began to
be, whatsoever had a beginning. The Word - So termed <scripRef passage="Psalm xxxiii. 6" id="i.v.ii-p1.3" parsed="|Ps|33|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.33.6">Psalm xxxiii, 6</scripRef>, and frequently by the seventy, and in the Chaldee
paraphrase. So that St. John did not borrow this expression from Philo,
or any heathen writer. He was not yet named Jesus, or Christ. He is the
Word whom the Father begat or spoke from eternity; by whom the Father
speaking, maketh all things; who speaketh the Father to us. We have, in
the 18th verse, both a real description of the Word, and the reason why
he is so called. He is the only begotten Son of the Father, who is in
the bosom of the Father, and hath declared him. And the Word was with
God - Therefore distinct from God the Father. The word rendered with,
denotes a perpetual tendency as it were of the Son to the Father, in
unity of essence. He was with God alone; because nothing beside God had
then any being. And the Word was God - Supreme, eternal, independent.
There was no creature, in respect of which he could be styled God in a
relative sense. Therefore he is styled so in the absolute sense. The
Godhead of the Messiah being clearly revealed in the Old Testament, (<scripRef passage="Jer. xxiii. 7" id="i.v.ii-p1.4" parsed="|Jer|23|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.23.7">Jer. xxiii, 7</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Hosea i. 6" id="i.v.ii-p1.5" parsed="|Hos|1|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.1.6">Hosea i, 6</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Psalm xxiii. 1" id="i.v.ii-p1.6" parsed="|Ps|23|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.23.1">Psalm xxiii, 1</scripRef>, ) the other evangelists aim at this, to prove that Jesus, a
true man, was the Messiah. But when, at length, some from hence began to
doubt of his Godhead, then St. John expressly asserted it, and wrote in
this book as it were a supplement to the Gospels, as in the Revelation
to the prophets.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p2">2. The same was in the beginning with God - This verse
repeats and contracts into one the three points mentioned before. As if
he had said, This Word, who was God, was in the beginning, and was with
God.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p3">3. All things beside God were made, and all things which
were made, were made by the Word. In the first and second verse is
described the state of things before the creation: verse 3, In the
creation: verse 4, In the time of man's innocency: verse 5, In the time
of man's corruption.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p4">4. In him was life - He was the foundation of life to every
living thing, as well as of being to all that is. And the life was the
light of men - He who is essential life, and the giver of life to all
that liveth, was also the light of men; the fountain of wisdom,
holiness, and happiness, to man in his original state.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p5">5. And the light shineth in darkness - Shines even on
fallen man; but the darkness - Dark, sinful man, perceiveth it not.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p6">6. There was a man - The evangelist now proceeds to him who
testified of the light, which he had spoken of in the five preceding
verses.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p7">7. The same came for (that is, in order to give) a
testimony - The evangelist, with the most strong and tender affection,
interweaves his own testimony with that of John, by noble digressions,
wherein he explains the office of the Baptist; partly premises and
partly subjoins a further explication to his short sentences. What St.
Matthew, Mark, and Luke term the Gospel, in respect of the promise going
before, St. John usually terms the testimony, intimating the certain
knowledge of the relator; to testify of the light - Of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p8">9. Who lighteth every man - By what is vulgarly termed
natural conscience, pointing out at least the general lines of good and
evil. And this light, if man did not hinder, would shine more and more
to the perfect day.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p9">10. He was in the world - Even from the creation.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p10">11. He came - In the fulness of time, to his own - Country,
city, temple: And his own - People, received him not.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p11">12. But as many as received him - Jews or Gentiles; that
believe on his name - That is, on him. The moment they believe, they are
sons; and because they are sons, God sendeth forth the Spirit of his Son
into their hearts, crying, Abba, Father.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p12">13. Who were born - Who became the sons of God, not of
blood - Not by descent from Abraham, nor by the will of the flesh - By
natural generation, nor by the will of man - Adopting them, but of God -
By his Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p13">14. Flesh sometimes signifies corrupt nature; sometimes the
body; sometimes, as here, the whole man. We beheld his glory - We his
apostles, particularly Peter, James, and John, <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 32" id="i.v.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Luke|9|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.32">Luke ix, 32</scripRef>. Grace and truth - We are all by nature liars and children
of wrath, to whom both grace and truth are unknown. But we are made
partakers of them, when we are accepted through the Beloved. The whole
verse might be paraphrased thus: And in order to raise us to this
dignity and happiness, the eternal Word, by a most amazing
condescension, was made flesh, united himself to our miserable nature,
with all its innocent infirmities. And he did not make us a transient
visit, but tabernacled among us on earth, displaying his glory in a more
eminent manner, than even of old in the tabernacle of Moses. And we who
are now recording these things beheld his glory with so strict an
attention, that we can testify, it was in every respect such a glory as
became the only begotten of the Father. For it shone forth not only in
his transfiguration, and in his continual miracles, but in all his
tempers, ministrations, and conduct through the whole series of his
life. In all he appeared full of grace and truth: he was himself most
benevolent and upright; made those ample discoveries of pardon to
sinners, which the Mosaic dispensation could not do: and really
exhibited the most substantial blessings, whereas that was but a shadow
of good things to come.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p14">15. John cried - With joy and confidence; This is he of
whom I said - John had said this before our Lord's baptism, although he
then knew him not in person: he knew him first at his baptism, and
afterward cried, This is he of whom I said. &amp;c. He is preferred
before me - in his office: for he was before me - in his nature.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p15">16. And - Here the apostle confirms the Baptist's words: as
if he had said, He is indeed preferred before thee: so we have
experienced: We all - That believe: have received - All that we enjoy
out of his fulness: and in the particular, grace upon grace - One
blessing upon another, immeasurable grace and love.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p16">17. The law - Working wrath and containing shadows: was
given - No philosopher, poet, or orator, ever chose his words so
accurately as St. John. The law, saith he, was given by Moses: grace was
by Jesus Christ. Observe the reason for placing each word thus: The law
of Moses was not his own. The grace of Christ was. His grace was
opposite to the wrath, his truth to the shadowy ceremonies of the law.
Jesus - St. John having once mentioned the incarnation (ver. 14,) no
more uses that name, the Word, in all his book.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p17">18. No man hath seen God - With bodily eyes: yet believers
see him with the eye of faith. Who is in the bosom of the Father - The
expression denotes the highest unity, and the most intimate
knowledge.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p18">19. The Jews - Probably the great council sent.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p19">20. I am not the Christ - For many supposed he was.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p20">21. Art thou Elijah? - He was not that Elijah (the
Tishbite) of whom they spoke. Art thou the prophet - Of whom Moses
speaks, <scripRef passage="Deut. xviii. 15" id="i.v.ii-p20.1" parsed="|Deut|18|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.18.15">Deut. xviii,
15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p21">23. He said - I am that forerunner of Christ of whom Isaiah
speaks. I am the voice - As if he had said, Far from being Christ, or
even Elijah, I am nothing but a voice: a sound that so soon as it has
expressed the thought of which it is the sign, dies into air, and is
known no more. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 3" id="i.v.ii-p21.1" parsed="|Isa|40|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.3">Isaiah xl,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p22">24. They who were sent were of the Pharisees - Who were
peculiarly tenacious of old customs, and jealous of any innovation
(except those brought in by their own scribes) unless the innovator had
unquestionable proofs of Divine authority.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p23">25. They asked him, Why baptizest thou then? - Without any
commission from the sanhedrim? And not only heathens (who were always
baptized before they were admitted to circumcision) but Jews also?</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p24">26. John answered, I baptize - To prepare for the Messiah;
and indeed to show that Jews, as well as Gentiles, must be proselytes to
Christ, and that these as well as those stand in need of being washed
from their sins.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p25">28. Where John was baptizing - That is, used to
baptize.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p26">29. He seeth Jesus coming and saith, Behold the Lamb -
Innocent; to be offered up; prophesied of by Isaiah, <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 7" id="i.v.ii-p26.1" parsed="|Isa|53|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.7">Isaiah liii, 7</scripRef>, typified by the paschal lamb, and by the daily sacrifice:
The Lamb of God - Whom God gave, approves, accepts of; who taketh away -
Atoneth for; the sin - That is, all the sins: of the world - Of all
mankind. Sin and the world are of equal extent.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p27">31. I knew him not - Till he came to be baptized. How
surprising is this; considering how nearly they were related, and how
remarkable the conception and birth of both had been. But there was a
peculiar providence visible in our saviour's living, from his infancy to
his baptism, at Nazareth: John all the time living the life of a hermit
in the deserts of Judea, <scripRef passage="Luke i. 80" id="i.v.ii-p27.1" parsed="|Luke|1|80|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1.80">Luke i,
80</scripRef>, ninety or more miles from Nazareth: hereby that
acquaintance was prevented which might have made John's testimony of
Christ suspected.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p28">34. I saw it - That is, the Spirit so descending and
abiding on him. And testified - From that time.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p29">37. They followed Jesus - They walked after him, but had
not the courage to speak to him.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p30">41. He first findeth his own brother Simon - Probably both
of them sought him: Which is, being interpreted, the Christ - This the
evangelist adds, as likewise those words in ver. 38, that is, being
interpreted, Master.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p31">42. Jesus said, Thou art Simon, the son of Jonah - As none
had told our Lord these names, this could not but strike Peter. Cephas,
which is Peter - Moaning the same in Syriac which Peter does in Greek,
namely, a rock.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p32">45. Jesus of Nazareth - So Philip thought, not knowing he
was born in Bethlehem. Nathanael was probably the same with Bartholomew,
that is, the son of Tholomew. St. Matthew joins Bartholomew with Philip,
<scripRef passage="Matt. x. 3" id="i.v.ii-p32.1" parsed="|Matt|10|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.3">Matt. x, 3</scripRef>, and St. John places Nathanael in the midst of the apostles,
immediately after Thomas, chap. xxi, 2, just as Bartholomew is placed, <scripRef passage="Acts i. 13" id="i.v.ii-p32.2" parsed="|Acts|1|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1.13">Acts i, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p33">46. Can any good thing come out of Nazareth? - How
cautiously should we guard against popular prejudices? When these had
once possessed so honest a heart as that of Nathanael, they led him to
suspect the blessed Jesus himself for an impostor, because he had been
brought up at Nazareth. But his integrity prevailed over that foolish
bias, and laid him open to the force of evidence, which a candid
inquirer will always be glad to admit, even when it brings the most
unexpected discoveries. Can any good thing - That is, have we ground
from Scripture to expect the Messiah, or any eminent prophet from
Nazareth? Philip saith, Come and see - The same answer which he had
received himself from our Lord the day before.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p34">48. Under the fig tree I saw thee - Perhaps at prayer.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p35">49. Nathanael answered - Happy are they that are ready to
believe, swift to receive the truth and grace of God. Thou art the Son
of God - So he acknowledges now more than he had heard from Philip: The
Son of God, the king of Israel - A confession both of the person and
office of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.ii-p36">51. Hereafter ye shall see - All of these, as well as thou,
who believe on me now in my state of humiliation, shall hereafter see me
come in my glory, and all the angels of God with me. This seems the most
natural sense of the words, though they may also refer to his
ascension.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="7.31%" prev="i.v.ii" next="i.v.iv" id="i.v.iii">
<h3 id="i.v.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John II" id="i.v.iii-p0.2" parsed="|John|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.2" /> 

<p id="i.v.iii-p1">1. And the third day - After he had said this. In Cana of
Galilee - There were two other towns of the same name, one in the tribe
of Ephraim, the other in Caelosyria.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p2">2. Jesus and his disciples were invited to the marriage -
Christ does not take away human society, but sanctifies it. Water might
have quenched thirst; yet our Lord allows wine; especially at a festival
solemnity. Such was his facility in drawing his disciples at first, who
were afterward to go through rougher ways.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p3">3. And wine falling short - How many days the solemnity had
lasted, and on which day our Lord came, or how many disciples might
follow him, does not appear. His mother saith to him, They have not wine
- Either she might mean, supply them by miracle; or, Go away, that
others may go also, before the want appears.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p4">4. Jesus saith to her, Woman - So our Lord speaks also,
chap. xix, 26. It is probable this was the constant appellation which he
used to her. He regarded his Father above all, not knowing even his
mother after the flesh. What is it to me and thee? A mild reproof of her
inordinate concern and untimely interposal. Mine hour is not yet come -
The time of my working this miracle, or of my going away. May we not
learn hence, if his mother was rebuked for attempting to direct him in
the days of his flesh, how absurd it is to address her as if she had a
right to command him, on the throne of his glory? Likewise how indecent
it is for us to direct his supreme wisdom, as to the time or manner in
which he shall appear for us in any of the exigencies of life!</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p5">5. His mother saith to the servants - Gathering from his
answer he was about to do something extraordinary.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p6">6. The purifying of the Jews - Who purified themselves by
frequent washings particularly before eating.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p7">9. The governor of the feast - The bridegroom generally
procured some friend to order all things at the entertainment.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p8">10. And saith - St. John barely relates the words he spoke,
which does not imply his approving them. When they have well drunk -
does not mean any more than toward the close of the entertainment.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p9">11. And his disciples believed - More steadfastly.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p10">14. Oxen, and sheep, and doves - Used for sacrifice: And
the changers of money - Those who changed foreign money for that which
was current at Jerusalem, for the convenience of them that came from
distant countries.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p11">15. Having made a scourge of rushes - (Which were strewed
on the ground, ) he drove all out of the temple, (that is, the court of
it, ) both the sheep and the oxen - Though it does not appear that he
struck even them; and much less, any of the men. But a terror from God,
it is evident, fell upon them.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p12">17. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxix. 9" id="i.v.iii-p12.1" parsed="|Ps|69|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.69.9">Psalm lxix,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p13">18. Then answered the Jews - Either some of those whom he
had just driven out, or their friends: What sign showest thou? - So they
require a miracle, to confirm a miracle!</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p14">19. This temple - Doubtless pointing, while he spoke, to
his body, the temple and habitation of the Godhead.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p15">20. Forty and six years - Just so many years before the
time of this conversation, Herod the Great had begun his most
magnificent reparation of the temple, (one part after another, ) which
he continued all his life, and which was now going on, and was continued
thirty-six years longer, till within six or seven years of the
destruction of the state, city, and temple by the Romans.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p16">22. They believed the scripture, and the word which Jesus
had said - Concerning his resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p17">23. Many believed - That he was a teacher sent from
God.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p18">24. He did not trust himself to them - Let us learn hence
not rashly to put ourselves into the power of others. Let us study a
wise and happy medium between universal suspiciousness and that easiness
which would make us the property of every pretender to kindness and
respect.</p>

<p id="i.v.iii-p19">25. He - To whom all things are naked, knew what was in man
- Namely, a desperately deceitful heart.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="7.38%" prev="i.v.iii" next="i.v.v" id="i.v.iv">
<h3 id="i.v.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John III" id="i.v.iv-p0.2" parsed="|John|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.3" /> 

<p id="i.v.iv-p1">1. A ruler - One of the great council.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p2">2. The same came - Through desire; but by night - Through
shame: We know - Even we rulers and Pharisees.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p3">3. Jesus answered - That knowledge will not avail thee
unless thou be born again - Otherwise thou canst not see, that is,
experience and enjoy, either the inward or the glorious kingdom of God.
In this solemn discourse our Lord shows, that no external profession, no
ceremonial ordinances or privileges of birth, could entitle any to the
blessings of the Messiah's kingdom: that an entire change of heart as
well as of life was necessary for that purpose: that this could only be
wrought in man by the almighty power of God: that every man born into
the world was by nature in a state of sin, condemnation, and misery:
that the free mercy of God had given his Son to deliver them from it,
and to raise them to a blessed immortality: that all mankind, Gentiles
as well as Jews, might share in these benefits, procured by his being
lifted up on the cross, and to be received by faith in him: but that if
they rejected him, their eternal, aggravated condemnation, would be the
certain consequence. Except a man be born again - If our Lord by being
born again means only reformation of life, instead of making any new
discovery, he has only thrown a great deal of obscurity on what was
before plain and obvious.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p4">4. When he is old - As Nicodemus himself was.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p5">5. Except a man be born of water and of the Spirit - Except
he experience that great inward change by the Spirit, and be baptized
(wherever baptism can be had) as the outward sign and means of it.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p6">6. That which is born of the flesh is flesh - Mere flesh,
void of the Spirit, yea, at enmity with it; And that which is born of
the Spirit is spirit - Is spiritual, heavenly, divine, like its
Author.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p7">7. Ye must be born again - To be born again, is to be
inwardly changed from all sinfulness to all holiness. It is fitly so
called, because as great a change then passes on the soul as passes on
the body when it is born into the world.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p8">8. The wind bloweth - According to its own nature, not thy
will, and thou hearest the sound thereof - Thou art sure it doth blow,
but canst not explain the particular manner of its acting. So is every
one that is born of the Spirit - The fact is plain, the manner of his
operations inexplicable.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p9">11. We speak what we know - I and all that believe in
me.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p10">12. Earthly things - Things done on earth; such as the new
birth, and the present privileges of the children of God. Heavenly
things - Such as the eternity of the Son, and the unity of the Father,
Son, and Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p11">13. For no one - For here you must rely on my single
testimony, whereas there you have a cloud of witnesses: Hath gone up to
heaven, but he that came down from heaven. Who is in heaven - Therefore
he is omnipresent; else he could not be in heaven and on earth at once.
This is a plain instance of what is usually termed the communication of
properties between the Divine and human nature; whereby what is proper
to the Divine nature is spoken concerning the human, and what is proper
to the human is, as here, spoken of the Divine.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p12">14. And as Moses - And even this single witness will soon
be taken from you; yea, and in a most ignominious manner. <scripRef passage="Num. xxi. 8, 9" id="i.v.iv-p12.1" parsed="|Num|21|8|21|9" osisRef="Bible:Num.21.8-Num.21.9">Num. xxi, 8, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p13">15. That whosoever - He must be lifted up, that hereby he
may purchase salvation for all believers: all those who look to him by
faith recover spiritual health, even as all that looked at that serpent
recovered bodily health.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p14">16. Yea, and this was the very design of God's love in
sending him into the world. Whosoever believeth on him - With that faith
which worketh by love, and hold fast the beginning of his confidence
steadfast to the end. God so loved the world - That is, all men under
heaven; even those that despise his love, and will for that cause
finally perish. Otherwise not to believe would be no sin to them. For
what should they believe? Ought they to believe that Christ was given
for them? Then he was given for them. He gave his only Son - Truly and
seriously. And the Son of God gave himself, <scripRef passage="Gal. iv. 4" id="i.v.iv-p14.1" parsed="|Gal|4|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.4.4">Gal. iv, 4</scripRef>, truly and seriously.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p15">17. God sent not his Son into the world to condemn the
world - Although many accuse him of it.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p16">18. He that believeth on him is not condemned - Is
acquitted, is justified before God. The name of the only-begotten Son of
God - The name of a person is often put for the person himself. But
perhaps it is farther intimated in that expression, that the person
spoken of is great and magnificent. And therefore it is generally used
to express either God the Father or the Son.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p17">19. This is the condemnation - That is, the cause of it. So
God is clear.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p18">21. He that practiceth the truth (that is, true religion)
cometh to the light - So even Nicodemus, afterward did. Are wrought in
God - That is, in the light, power, and love of God.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p19">22. Jesus went - From the capital city, Jerusalem, into the
land of Judea - That is, into the country. There he baptized - Not
himself; but his disciples by his order, chap. iv, 2.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p20">23. John also was baptizing - He did not repel them that
offered, but he more willingly referred them to Jesus.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p21">25. The Jews - Those men of Judea, who now went to be
baptized by Jesus; and John's disciples, who were mostly of Galilee:
about purifying - That is, baptism. They disputed, which they should be
baptized by.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p22">27. A man can receive nothing - Neither he nor I. Neither
could he do this, unless God had sent him: nor can I receive the title
of Christ, or any honour comparable to that which he hath received from
heaven. They seem to have spoken with jealousy and resentment; John
answers with sweet composure of spirit.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p23">29. He that hath the bride is the bridegroom - He whom the
bride follows. But all men now come to Jesus. Hence it is plain he is
the bridegroom. The friend who heareth him - Talk with the bride;
rejoiceth greatly - So far from envying or resenting it.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p24">30. He must increase, but I must decrease - So they who are
now, like John, burning and shining lights, must (if not suddenly
eclipsed) like him gradually decrease, while others are increasing about
them; as they in their turns grew up, amidst the decays of the former
generation. Let us know how to set, as well as how to rise; and let it
comfort our declining days to trace, in those who are likely to succeed
us in our work, the openings of yet greater usefulness.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p25">31. It is not improbable, that what is added, to the end of
the chapter, are the words of the evangelist, not the Baptist. He that
is of the earth - A mere man; of earthly original, has a spirit and
speech answerable to it.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p26">32. No man - None comparatively, exceeding few; receiveth
his testimony - With true faith.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p27">33. Hath set to his seal - It was customary among the Jews
for the witness to set his seal to the testimony he had given. That God
is true - Whose words the Messiah speaks.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p28">34. God giveth not him the Spirit by measure - As he did to
the prophets, but immeasurably. Hence he speaketh the words of God in
the most perfect manner.</p>

<p id="i.v.iv-p29">36. He that believeth on the Son hath everlasting life - He
hath it already. For he loves God. And love is the essence of heaven. He
that obeyeth not - a consequence of not believing.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="7.51%" prev="i.v.iv" next="i.v.vi" id="i.v.v">
<h3 id="i.v.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John IV" id="i.v.v-p0.2" parsed="|John|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.4" /> 

<p id="i.v.v-p1">1. The Lord knew - Though none informed him of it.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p2">3. He left Judea - To shun the effects of their
resentment.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p3">4. And he must needs go through Samaria - The road lying
directly through it.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p4">5. Sychar - Formerly called Sichem or Shechem. Jacob gave -
On his death bed, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlviii. 22" id="i.v.v-p4.1" parsed="|Gen|48|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.48.22">Gen. xlviii,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p5">6. Jesus sat down - Weary as he was. It was the sixth hour
- Noon; the heat of the day.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p6">7. Give me to drink - In this one conversation he brought
her to that knowledge which the apostles were so long in attaining.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p7">8. For his disciples were gone - Else he needed not have
asked her.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p8">9. How dost thou - Her open simplicity appears from her
very first words. The Jews have no dealings - None by way of friendship.
They would receive no kind of favour from them.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p9">10. If thou hadst known the gift - The living water; and
who it is - He who alone is able to give it: thou wouldst have asked of
him - On those words the stress lies. Water - In like manner he draws
the allegory from bread, chap. vi, 27, and from light, viii, 12; the
first, the most simple, necessary, common, and salutary things in
nature. Living water - The Spirit and its fruits. But she might the more
easily mistake his meaning, because living water was a common phrase
among the Jews for spring water.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p10">12. Our father Jacob - So they fancied he was; whereas they
were, in truth, a mixture of many nations, placed there by the king of
Assyria, in the room of the Israelites whom he had carried away captive,
<scripRef passage="2 Kings xvii. 24" id="i.v.v-p10.1" parsed="|2Kgs|17|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.17.24">2 Kings xvii, 24</scripRef>. Who gave us the well - In Joseph their supposed forefather:
and drank thereof - So even he had no better water than this.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p11">14. Will never thirst - Will never (provided he continue to
drink thereof) be miserable, dissatisfied, without refreshment. If ever
that thirst returns, it will be the fault of the man, not the water. But
the water that I shall give him - The spirit of faith working by love,
shall become in him - An inward living principle, a fountain - Not
barely a well, which is soon exhausted, springing up into everlasting
life - Which is a confluence, or rather an ocean of streams arising from
this fountain.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p12">15. That I thirst not - She takes him still in a gross
sense.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p13">16. Jesus saith to her - He now clears the way that he
might give her a better kind of water than she asked for. Go, call thy
husband - He strikes directly at her bosom sin.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p14">17. Thou hast well said - We may observe in all our Lord's
discourses the utmost weightiness, and yet the utmost courtesy.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p15">18. Thou hast had five husbands - Whether they were all
dead or not, her own conscience now awakened would tell her.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p16">19. Sir, I perceive - So soon was her heart touched.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p17">20. The instant she perceived this, she proposes what she
thought the most important of all questions. This mountain - Pointing to
Mount Gerizim. Sanballat, by the permission of Alexander the Great, had
built a temple upon Mount Gerizim, for Manasseh, who for marrying
Sanballat's daughter had been expelled from the priesthood and from
Jerusalem, <scripRef passage="Neh. xiii. 28" id="i.v.v-p17.1" parsed="|Neh|13|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.13.28">Neh. xiii, 28</scripRef>. This was the place where the Samaritans used to worship in
opposition to Jerusalem. And it was so near Sychar, that a man's voice
might be heard from the one to the other. Our fathers worshipped - This
plainly refers to Abraham and Jacob (from whom the Samaritans pretended
to deduce their genealogy) who erected altars in this place: <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 6, 7" id="i.v.v-p17.2" parsed="|Gen|12|6|12|7" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.6-Gen.12.7">Gen. xii, 6, 7</scripRef>, and <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxiii. 18, 20" id="i.v.v-p17.3" parsed="|Gen|33|18|0|0;|Gen|33|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.33.18 Bible:Gen.33.20">Gen. xxxiii, 18, 20</scripRef>. And possibly to the whole congregation, who were directed
when they came into the land of Canaan to put the blessing upon Mount
Gerizim, <scripRef passage="Deut. xi. 29" id="i.v.v-p17.4" parsed="|Deut|11|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.11.29">Deut. xi, 29</scripRef>. Ye Jews say, In Jerusalem is the place - Namely, the
temple.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p18">21. Believe me - Our Lord uses this expression in this
manner but once; and that to a Samaritan. To his own people, the Jews,
his usual language is, I say unto you. The hour cometh when ye - Both
Samaritans and Jews, shall worship neither in this mountain, nor at
Jerusalem - As preferable to any other place. True worship shall be no
longer confined to any one place or nation.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p19">22. Ye worship ye know not what - Ye Samaritans are
ignorant, not only of the place, but of the very object of worship.
Indeed, they feared the Lord after a fashion; but at the same time
served their own gods, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xvii. 33" id="i.v.v-p19.1" parsed="|2Kgs|17|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.17.33">2 Kings
xvii, 33</scripRef>. Salvation is from the Jews - So spake all the prophets,
that the saviour should arise out of the Jewish nation: and that from
thence the knowledge of him should spread to all nations under
heaven.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p20">23. The true worshippers shall worship the Father - Not
here or there only, but at all times and in all places.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p21">24. God is a Spirit - Not only remote from the body, and
all the properties of it, but likewise full of all spiritual
perfections, power, wisdom, love, holiness. And our worship should be
suitable to his nature. We should worship him with the truly spiritual
worship of faith, love, and holiness, animating all our tempers,
thoughts, words, and actions.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p22">25. The woman saith - With joy for what she had already
learned, and desire of fuller instruction.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p23">26. Jesus saith - Hasting to satisfy her desire before his
disciples came. l am He - Our Lord did not speak this so plainly to the
Jews who were so full of the Messiah's temporal kingdom. If he had, many
would doubtless have taken up arms in his favour, and others have
accused him to the Roman governor. Yet he did in effect declare the
thing, though he denied the particular title. For in a multitude of
places he represented himself, both as the Son of man, and as the Son of
God: both which expressions were generally understood by the Jews as
peculiarly applicable to the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p24">27. His disciples marvelled that he talked with a woman -
Which the Jewish rabbis reckoned scandalous for a man of distinction to
do. They marvelled likewise at his talking with a woman of that nation,
which was so peculiarly hateful to the Jews. Yet none said - To the
woman, What seekest thou? - Or to Christ, Why talkest thou with her?</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p25">28. The woman left her water pot - Forgetting smaller
things.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p26">29. A man who told me all things that ever I did - Our Lord
had told her but a few things. But his words awakened her conscience,
which soon told her all the rest. Is not this the Christ? - She does not
doubt of it herself, but incites them to make the inquiry.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p27">31. In the meantime - Before the people came.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p28">34. My meat - That which satisfies the strongest appetite
of my soul.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p29">35. The fields are white already - As if he had said, The
spiritual harvest is ripe already. The Samaritans, ripe for the Gospel,
covered the ground round about them.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p30">36. He that reapeth - Whoever saves souls, receiveth wages
- A peculiar blessing to himself, and gathereth fruit - Many souls: that
he that soweth - Christ the great sower of the seed, and he that reapeth
may rejoice together - In heaven.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p31">37. That saying - A common proverb; One soweth - The
prophets and Christ; another reapeth - The apostles and succeeding
ministers.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p32">38. I - he Lord of the whole harvest, have sent you - He
had employed them already in baptizing, ver. 2.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p33">42. We know that this is the saviour of the world - And not
of the Jews only.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p34">43. He went into Galilee - That is, into the country of
Galilee: but not to Nazareth. It was at that town only that he had no
honour. Therefore he went to other towns.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p35">44. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 57" id="i.v.v-p35.1" parsed="|Matt|13|57|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.57">Matt. xiii,
57</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p36">47. To come down - For Cana stood much higher than
Capernaum.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p37">48. Unless ye see signs and wonders - Although the
Samaritans believed without them.</p>

<p id="i.v.v-p38">52. He asked the hour when he amended - The more exactly
the works of God are considered, the more faith is increased.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="7.64%" prev="i.v.v" next="i.v.vii" id="i.v.vi">
<h3 id="i.v.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John V" id="i.v.vi-p0.2" parsed="|John|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.5" /> 

<p id="i.v.vi-p1">1. A feast - Pentecost.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p2">2. There is in Jerusalem - Hence it appears, that St. John
wrote his Gospel before Jerusalem was destroyed: it is supposed about
thirty years after the ascension. Having five porticos - Built for the
use of the sick. Probably the basin had five sides! Bethesda signifies
the house of mercy.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p3">4. An angel - Yet many undoubtedly thought the whole thing
to be purely natural. At certain times - Perhaps at a certain hour of
the day, during this paschal week, went down - The Greek word implies
that he had ceased going down, before the time of St. John's writing
this. God might design this to raise expectation of the acceptable time
approaching, to add a greater lustre to his Son's miracles, and to show
that his ancient people were not entirely forgotten of him. The first -
Whereas the Son of God healed every day not one only, but whole
multitudes that resorted to him.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p4">7. The sick man answered - Giving the reason why he was not
made whole, notwithstanding his desire.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p5">14. Sin no more - It seems his former illness was the
effect or punishment of sin.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p6">15. The man went and told the Jews, that it was Jesus who
had made him whole - One might have expected, that when he had published
the name of his benefactor, crowds would have thronged about Jesus, to
have heard the words of his mouth, and to have received the blessings of
the Gospel. Instead of this, they surround him with a hostile intent:
they even conspire against his life, and for an imagined transgression
in point of ceremony, would have put out this light of Israel. Let us
not wonder then, if our good be evil spoken of: if even candour,
benevolence, and usefulness, do not disarm the enmity of those who have
been taught to prefer sacrifice to mercy; and who, disrelishing the
genuine Gospel, naturally seek to slander and persecute the professors,
but especially the defenders of it.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p7">17. My Father worketh until now, and I work - From the
creation till now he hath been working without intermission. I do
likewise. This is the proposition which is explained ver. 19-30,
confirmed and vindicated in ver. 31 and following verses.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p8">18. His own Father - The Greek word means his own Father in
such a sense as no creature can speak. Making himself equal with God -
It is evident all the hearers so understood him, and that our Lord never
contradicted, but confirmed it.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p9">19. The Son can do nothing of himself - This is not his
imperfection, but his glory, resulting from his eternal, intimate,
indissoluble unity with the Father. Hence it is absolutely impossible,
that the Son should judge, will, testify, or teach any thing without the
Father, ver. 30, &amp;c.; chap. vi, 38; chap. vii, 16; or that he should
be known or believed on, separately from the Father. And he here defends
his doing good every day, without intermission, by the example of his
Father, from which he cannot depart: these doth the Son likewise - All
these, and only these; seeing he and the Father are one.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p10">20. The Father showeth him all things that himself doth - A
proof of the most intimate unity. And he will show him - By doing them.
At the same time (not at different times) the Father showeth and doth,
and the Son seeth and doth. Greater works - Jesus oftener terms them
works, than signs or wonders, because they were not wonders in his eyes.
Ye will marvel - So they did, when he raised Lazarus.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p11">21. For - He declares which are those greater works,
raising the dead, and judging the world. The power of quickening whom he
will follows from the power of judging. These two, quickening and
judging, are proposed ver. 21, 22. The acquittal of believers, which
presupposes judgment, is treated of ver. 24; the quickening some of the
dead, ver. 25; and the general resurrection, ver. 28.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p12">22. For neither doth the Father judge - Not without the
Son: but he doth judge by that man whom he hath ordained, <scripRef passage="Acts xvii. 31" id="i.v.vi-p12.1" parsed="|Acts|17|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.17.31">Acts xvii, 31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p13">23. That all men may honour the Son, even as they honour
the Father - Either willingly, and so escaping condemnation, by faith:
or unwillingly, when feeling the wrath of the Judge. This demonstrates
the EQUALITY of the Son with the Father. If our Lord were God only by
office or investiture, and not in the unity of the Divine essence, and
in all respects equal in Godhead with the Father, he could not be
honoured even as, that is, with the same honour that they honoured the
Father. He that honoureth not the Son - With the same equal honour,
greatly dishonoureth the Father that sent him.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p14">24. And cometh not into condemnation - Unless he make
shipwreck of the faith.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p15">25. The dead shall hear the voice of the Son of God - So
did Jairus's daughter, the widow's son, Lazarus.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p16">26. He hath given to the Son - By eternal generation, to
have life in himself - Absolute, independent.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p17">27. Because he is the Son of man - He is appointed to judge
mankind because he was made man.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p18">28. The time is coming - When not two or three, but all
shall rise.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p19">29. The resurrection of life - That resurrection which
leads to life everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p20">30. I can do nothing of myself - It is impossible I should
do any thing separately from my Father. As I hear - Of the Father, and
see, so I judge and do; A because I am essentially united to him. See
ver. 19.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p21">31. If I testify of myself - That is, if I alone, (which
indeed is impossible,) my testimony is not valid.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p22">32. There is another - The Father, ver. 37, and I know
that, even in your judgment, his testimony is beyond exception.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p23">33. He bare testimony - That I am the Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p24">34. But I have no need to receive, &amp;c. But these things
- Concerning John, whom ye yourselves reverence, I say, that ye may be
saved - So really and seriously did he will their salvation. Yet they
were not saved. Most, if not all of them, died in their sins.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p25">35. He was a burning and a shining light - Inwardly burning
with love and zeal, outwardly shining in all holiness. And even ye were
willing for a season - A short time only.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p26">37. He hath testified of me - Namely at my baptism. I speak
not of my supposed father Joseph. Ye are utter strangers to him of whom
I speak.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p27">38. Ye have not his word - All who believe have the word of
the Father (the same with the word of the Son) abiding in them, that is,
deeply ingrafted in their hearts.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p28">39. Search the Scriptures - A plain command to all men. In
them ye are assured ye have eternal life - Ye know they show you the way
to eternal life. And these very Scriptures testify of me.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p29">40. Yet ye will not come unto me - As they direct you.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p30">41. I receive not honour from men - I need it not. I seek
it not from you for my own sake.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p31">42. But I know you - With this ray he pierces the hearts of
the hearers. And this doubtless he spake with the tenderest
compassion.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p32">43. If another shall come - Any false Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p33">44. While ye receive honour - That is, while ye seek the
praise of men rather than the praise of God. At the feast of pentecost,
kept in commemoration of the giving the law from Mount Sinai, their
sermons used to be full of the praises of the law, and of the people to
whom it was given. How mortifying then must the following words of our
Lord be to them, while they were thus exulting in Moses and his law!</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p34">45. There is one that accuseth you - By his writings.</p>

<p id="i.v.vi-p35">46. He wrote of me - Everywhere; in all his writings;
particularly <scripRef passage="Deut. xviii. 15, 18" id="i.v.vi-p35.1" parsed="|Deut|18|15|0|0;|Deut|18|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.18.15 Bible:Deut.18.18">Deut. xviii, 15,
18</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="7.77%" prev="i.v.vi" next="i.v.viii" id="i.v.vii">
<h3 id="i.v.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John VI" id="i.v.vii-p0.2" parsed="|John|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.6" /> 

<p id="i.v.vii-p1">1. After these things - The history of between ten and
eleven months is to be supplied here from the other evangelists. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 13" id="i.v.vii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|14|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.13">Matt. xiv, 13</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 32" id="i.v.vii-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|6|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.32">Mark
vi, 32</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke ix. 10" id="i.v.vii-p1.3" parsed="|Luke|9|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.9.10">Luke ix,
10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p2">3. Jesus went up - Before the people overtook him.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p3">5. Jesus saith to Philip - Perhaps he had the care of
providing victuals for the family of the apostles.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p4">15. He retired to the mountain alone - Having ordered his
disciples to cross over the lake.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p5">16. <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 22" id="i.v.vii-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|14|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.22">Matt. xiv,
22</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 45" id="i.v.vii-p5.2" parsed="|Mark|6|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.45">Mark vi,
45</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p6">22. Who had stood on the other side - They were forced to
stay a while, because there were then no other vessels; and they stayed
the less unwillingly, because they saw that Jesus was not embarked.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p7">26. Our Lord does not satisfy their curiosity, but corrects
the wrong motive they had in seeking him: because ye did eat - Merely
for temporal advantage. Hitherto Christ had been gathering hearers: he
now begins to try their sincerity, by a figurative discourse concerning
his passion, and the fruit of it, to be received by faith.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p8">27. labour not for the meat which perisheth - For bodily
food: not for that only not chiefly: not at all, but in subordination to
grace, faith, love, the meat which endureth to everlasting life. labour,
work for this; foreverlasting life. So our Lord expressly commands,
work for life, as well as from life: from a principle of faith and love.
Him hath the Father sealed - By this very miracle, as well as by his
whole testimony concerning him. See chap. iii, 33. Sealing is a mark of
the authenticity of a writing.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p9">28. The works of God - Works pleasing to God.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p10">29. This is the work of God - The work most pleasing to
God, and the foundation of all others: that ye believe - He expresses it
first properly, afterward figuratively.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p11">30. What sign dost thou? - Amazing, after what they had
just seen!</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p12">31. Our fathers ate manna - This sign Moses gave them. He
gave them bread from heaven - From the lower sublunary heaven; to which
Jesus opposes the highest heaven: in which sense he says seven times,
ver. 32, 33, 38, 50, 58, 62, that he himself came down from heaven.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p13">32. Moses gave you not bread from heaven - It was not Moses
who gave the manna to your fathers; but my Father who now giveth the
true bread from heaven. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxviii. 24" id="i.v.vii-p13.1" parsed="|Ps|78|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.78.24">Psalm
lxxviii, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p14">33. He that - giveth life to the world - Not (like the
manna) to one people only: and that from generation to generation. Our
Lord does not yet say, I am that bread; else the Jews would not have
given him so respectful an answer, ver. 34.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p15">34. Give us this bread - Meaning it still, in a literal
sense: yet they seem now to be not far from believing.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p16">35. I am the bread of life - Having and giving life: he
that cometh -he that believeth - Equivalent expressions: shall never
hunger, thirst - Shall be satisfied, happy, forever.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p17">36. I have told you - Namely, ver. 26.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p18">37. All that the Father giveth me - All that feel
themselves lost, and follow the drawings of the Father, he in a peculiar
manner giveth to the Son: will come to me - By faith. And him that thus
cometh to me, I will in nowise cast out - I will give him pardon,
holiness, and heaven, if he endure to the end - to rejoice in his
light.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p19">39. Of all which he hath already given me - See chap. xvii,
6, 12. If they endure to the end. But Judas did not.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p20">40. Here is the sum of the three foregoing verses. This is
the will of him that sent me - This is the whole of what I have said:
this is the eternal, unchangeable will of God. Everyone who truly
believeth, shall have everlasting life. Everyone that seeth and
believeth - The Jews saw, and yet believed not. And I will raise him up
- As this is the will of him that sent me, I will perform it
effectually.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p21">44. Christ having checked their murmuring, continues what
he was saying, ver. 40. No man comes to me, unless my Father draw him -
No man can believe in Christ, unless God give him power: he draws us
first, by good desires. Not by compulsion, not by laying the will under
any necessity; but by the strong and sweet, yet still resistible,
motions of his heavenly grace.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p22">45. Every man that hath heard - The secret voice of God,
he, and he only believeth. <scripRef passage="Isaiah liv. 13" id="i.v.vii-p22.1" parsed="|Isa|54|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.54.13">Isaiah
liv, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p23">46. Not that any one - Must expect him to appear in a
visible shape. He who is from or with God - In a more eminent manner
than any creature.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p24">50. Not die - Not spiritually; not eternally.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p25">51. If any eat of this bread - That is, believe in me: he
shall live forever - In other words, he that believeth to the end shall
be saved. My flesh which I will give you - This whole discourse
concerning his flesh and blood refers directly to his passion, and but
remotely, if at all, to the Lord's Supper.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p26">52. Observe the degrees: the Jews are tried here; the
disciples, ver. 60-66, the apostles, ver. 67.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p27">53. Unless ye eat the flesh of the Son of man -
Spiritually: unless ye draw continual virtue from him by faith. Eating
his flesh is only another expression for believing.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p28">55. Meat - drink indeed - With which the soul of a believer
is as truly fed, as his body with meat and drink.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p29">57. I live by the Father - Being one with him. He shall
live by me -Being one with me. Amazing union!</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p30">58. This is - That is, I am the bread - Which is not like
the manna your fathers ate, who died notwithstanding.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p31">60. This is a hard saying - Hard to the children of the
world, but sweet to the children of God. Scarce ever did our Lord speak
more sublimely, even to the apostles in private. Who can hear - Endure
it?</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p32">62. What if ye shall see the Son of man ascend where he was
before? - How much more incredible will it then appear to you, that he
should give you his flesh to eat?</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p33">63. It is the Spirit - The spiritual meaning of these
words, by which God giveth life. The flesh - The bare, carnal, literal
meaning, profiteth nothing. The words which I have spoken, they are
spirit - Are to be taken in a spiritual sense and, when they are so
understood, they are life - That is, a means of spiritual life to the
hearers.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p34">64. But there are some of you who believe not - And so
receive no life by them, because you take them in a gross literal sense.
For Jesus knew from the beginning - Of his ministry: who would betray
him - Therefore it is plain, God does foresee future contingencies:-
"But his foreknowledge causes not the fault, Which had no less proved
certain unforeknown."</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p35">65. Unless it be given - And it is given to those only who
will receive it on God's own terms.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p36">66. From this time many of his disciples went back - So our
Lord now began to purge his floor: the proud and careless were driven
away, and those remained who were meet for the Master's use.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p37">68. Thou hast the words of eternal life - Thou, and thou
alone, speakest the words which show the way to life everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p38">69. And we - Who have been with thee from the beginning,
whatever others do, have known - Are absolutely assured, that thou art
the Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.vii-p39">70. Jesus answered the - And yet even ye have not all acted
suitable to this knowledge. Have I not chosen or elected you twelve? -
But they might fall even from that election. Yet one of you - On this
gracious warning, Judas ought to have repented; is a devil - Is now
influenced by one.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="7.90%" prev="i.v.vii" next="i.v.ix" id="i.v.viii">
<h3 id="i.v.viii-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John VII" id="i.v.viii-p0.2" parsed="|John|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.7" /> 

<p id="i.v.viii-p1">1. After these things Jesus walked in Galilee - That is,
continued there, for some months after the second passover. For he would
not walk - Continue in Judea; because the Jews - Those of them who did
not believe; and in particular the chief priests, scribes, and
Pharisees, sought an opportunity to kill him.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p2">2. The feast of tabernacles - The time, manner, and reason
of this feast may be seen, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxiii. 34" id="i.v.viii-p2.1" parsed="|Lev|23|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.23.34">Lev.
xxiii, 34</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p3">3. His brethren -- so called according to the Jewish way of
speaking. They were his cousins, the sons of his mother's sister. Depart
hence - From this obscure place.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p4">4. For no man doth any thing - Of this kind, in secret; but
rather desireth to be of public use. If thou really dost these things
-These miracles which are reported; show thyself to the world - To all
men.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p5">6. Jesus saith, Your time is always ready - This or any
time will suit you.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p6">7. The world cannot hate you - Because ye are of the world.
But me it hateth - And all that bear the same testimony.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p7">10. He also went up to the feast - This was his last
journey but one to Jerusalem. The next time he went up he suffered.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p8">11. The Jews - The men of Judea, particularly of
Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p9">12. There was much murmuring among the multitude - Much
whispering; many private debates with each other, among those who were
come from distant parts.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p10">13. However no man spake openly of him - Not in favour of
him: for fear of the Jews - Those that were in authority.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p11">14. Now at the middle of the feast - Which lasted eight
days. It is probable this was on the Sabbath day. Jesus went up into the
temple - Directly, without stopping any where else.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p12">15. How does this man know letters, having never learned? -
How come he to be so well acquainted with sacred literature as to be
able thus to expound the Scripture, with such propriety and
gracefulness, seeing he has never learned this, at any place of
education?</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p13">16. My doctrine is not mine - Acquired by any labour of
learning; but his that sent me - Immediately infused by him.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p14">17. If any man be willing to do his will, he shall know of
the doctrine, whether it be of God - This is a universal rule, with
regard to all persons and doctrines. He that is thoroughly willing to do
it, shall certainly know what the will of God is.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p15">18. There is no unrighteousness in him - No deceit or
falsehood.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p16">19. But ye are unrighteous; for ye violate the very law
which ye profess so much zeal for.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p17">20. The people answered, Thou hast a devil - A lying
spirit. Who seeketh to kill thee? - These, coming from distant parts,
probably did not know the design of the priests and rulers.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p18">21. I did - At the pool of Bethesda: one work - Out of
many: and ye all marvelled at it - Are amazed, because I did it on the
Sabbath day.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p19">22. Moses gave you circumcision - The sense is, because
Moses enjoined your circumcision (though indeed it was far more ancient
than him) you think it no harm to circumcise a man on the Sabbath: and
are ye angry at me (which anger had now continued sixteen months) for
doing so much greater a good, for healing a man, body and soul, on the
Sabbath?</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p20">27. When Christ cometh, none knoweth whence he is - This
Jewish tradition was true, with regard to his Divine nature: in that
respect none could declare his generation. But it was not true with
regard to his human nature, for both his family and the place of his
birth were plainly foretold.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p21">28. Then cried Jesus - With a loud and earnest voice. Do ye
both know me, and know whence I am? - Ye do indeed know whence I am as a
man. But ye know not my Divine nature, nor that I am sent from God.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p22">29. l am from him - By eternal generation: and he hath sent
me - His mission follows from his generation. These two points answer
those: Do ye know me? Do ye know whence I am?</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p23">30. His hour - The time of his suffering.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p24">33. Then said Jesus - Continuing his discourse (from ver.
29) which they had interrupted.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p25">34. Ye shall seek me - Whom ye now despise. These words
are, as it were, the text which is commented upon in this and the
following chapter. Where I am - Christ's so frequently saying while on
earth, where I am, when he spake of his being in heaven, intimates his
perpetual presence there in his Divine nature: though his going thither
was a future thing, with regard to his human nature.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p26">35. Will he go to the dispersed among the Greeks - The Jews
scattered abroad in heathen nations, Greece particularly. Or, Will he
teach the Greeks? - The heathens themselves.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p27">37. On the last, the great day of the feast - On this day
there was the greatest concourse of people, and they were then wont to
fetch water from the fountain of Siloam, which the priests poured out on
the great altar, singing one to an other, With joy shall ye draw water
from the wells of salvation. On this day likewise they commemorated
God's miraculously giving water out of the rock, and offered up solemn
prayers for seasonable rains.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p28">38. He that believeth - This answers to let him come to me.
And whosoever doth come to him by faith, his inmost soul shall be filled
with living water, with abundance of peace, joy, and love, which shall
likewise flow from him to others. As the Scripture hath said - Not
expressly in any one particular place. But here is a general reference
to all those scriptures which speak of the effusion of the Spirit by the
Messiah, under the similitude of pouring out water. <scripRef passage="Zech. xiv. 8" id="i.v.viii-p28.1" parsed="|Zech|14|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.14.8">Zech. xiv, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p29">39. The Holy Ghost was not yet given - That is, those
fruits of the Spirit were not yet given even to true believers, in that
full measure.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p30">40. The prophet - Whom we expect to be the forerunner of
the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p31">42. From Bethlehem - And how could they forget that Jesus
was born there? Had not Herod given them terrible reason to remember it?
<scripRef passage="Micah v. 2" id="i.v.viii-p31.1" parsed="|Mic|5|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mic.5.2">Micah v, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p32">48. Hath any of the rulers - Men of rank or eminence, or of
the Pharisees - Men of learning or religion, believed on him?</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p33">49. But this populace, who know not the law - This ignorant
rabble; are accursed - Are by that ignorance exposed to the curse of
being thus seduced.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p34">50. Nicodemus, he that came to him by night - Having now a
little more courage, being one of them - Being present as a member of
the great council, saith to them - Do not we ourselves act as if we knew
not the law, if we pass sentence on a man before we hear him?</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p35">52. They answered - By personal reflection; the argument
they could not answer, and therefore did not attempt it. Art thou also a
Galilean? - One of his party? Out of Galilee ariseth no prophet - They
could not but know the contrary. They knew Jonah arose out of
Gethhepher; and Nahum from another village in Galilee. Yea, and Thisbe,
the town of Elijah, the Tishbite, was in Galilee also. They might
likewise have known that Jesus was not born in Galilee, but at
Bethlehem, even from the public register there, and from the genealogies
of the family of David. They were conscious this poor answer would not
bear examination, and so took care to prevent a reply.</p>

<p id="i.v.viii-p36">53. And every man went to his own house - So that short
plain question of Nicodemus spoiled all their measures, and broke up the
council! A word spoken in season, how good it is! Especially when God
gives it his blessing.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="8.02%" prev="i.v.viii" next="i.v.x" id="i.v.ix">
<h3 id="i.v.ix-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John VIII" id="i.v.ix-p0.2" parsed="|John|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.8" /> 

<p id="i.v.ix-p1">5. Moses hath commanded us to stone such - If they spoke
accurately, this must have been a woman, who, having been betrothed to a
husband, had been guilty of this crime before the marriage was
completed; for such only Moses commanded to be stoned. He commanded
indeed that other adulteresses should be put to death; but the manner of
death was not specified. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxii. 23" id="i.v.ix-p1.1" parsed="|Deut|22|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.22.23">Deut. xxii, 23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p2">6. That they might have to accuse him - Either of usurping
the office of a judge, if he condemned her, or of being an enemy to the
law, if he acquitted her. Jesus stooping down, wrote with his finger on
the ground - God wrote once in the Old Testament; Christ once in the
New: perhaps the words which he afterward spoke, when they continued
asking him. By this silent action, he, 1, fixed their wandering,
hurrying thoughts, in order to awaken their consciences: and, 2,
signified that he was not then come to condemn but to save the
world.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p3">7. He that is without sin - He that is not guilty: his own
conscience being the judge) either of the same sin, or of some nearly
resembling it; let him - as a witness, cast the first stone at her.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p4">9. Beginning at the eldest - Or the elders. Jesus was left
alone -By all those scribes and Pharisees who proposed the question. But
many others remained, to whom our Lord directed his discourse presently
after.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p5">10. Hath no man condemned thee? - Hath no judicial sentence
been passed upon thee?</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p6">11. Neither do I condemn thee - Neither do I take upon me
to pass any such sentence. Let this deliverance lead thee to
repentance.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p7">12. He that followeth me shall in nowise walk in darkness -
In ignorance, wickedness, misery: but shall have the light of life -He
that closely, humbly, steadily follows me, shall have the Divine light
continually shining upon him, diffusing over his soul knowledge,
holiness, joy, till he is guided by it to life everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p8">13. Thou testifiest of thyself; thy testimony is not valid
- They retort upon our Lord his own words, chap. v, 31; if I testify of
myself, my testimony is not valid. He had then added, There is another
who testifieth of me. To the same effect he replies here, verse 14,
Though I testify of myself, yet my testimony is valid; for I am
inseparably united to the Father. I know - And from firm and certain
knowledge proceeds the most unexceptionable testimony: whence I came,
and whither I go - To these two heads may be referred all the doctrine
concerning Christ. The former is treated of verse 16, &amp;c., the
latter ver. 21, &amp;c. For I know whence I came - That is, For I came
from God, both as God and as man. And I know it, though ye do not.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p9">15. Ye judge after the flesh - As the flesh, that is,
corrupt nature dictates. I judge no man - Not thus; not now; not at my
first coming.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p10">16. I am not alone - No more in judging, than in
testifying: but I and the Father that sent me - His Father is in him,
and he is in the Father, chap. xiv, 10, 11; and so the Father is no more
alone without the Son, than the Son is without the Father, <scripRef passage="Prov. viii. 22, 23, 30" id="i.v.ix-p10.1" parsed="|Prov|8|22|8|23;|Prov|8|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.8.22-Prov.8.23 Bible:Prov.8.30">Prov. viii, 22, 23, 30</scripRef>. His Father and he are not one and another God, but one God,
(though distinct persons,) and so inseparable from each other. And
though the Son came from the Father, to assume human nature, and perform
his office as the Messiah upon earth, as God is sometimes said to come
from heaven, for particular manifestations of himself; yet Christ did
not leave the Father, nor the Father leave him, any more than God leaves
heaven when he is said to come down to the earth.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p11">17. <scripRef passage="Deut. xix. 15" id="i.v.ix-p11.1" parsed="|Deut|19|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.19.15">Deut. xix,
15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p12">19. Then said they to him, Where is thy Father? Jesus
answered - Showing the perverseness of their question; and teaching that
they ought first to know the Son, if they would know the Father. Where
the Father is - he shows, ver. 23. Meantime he plainly intimates that
the Father and he were distinct persons, as they were two witnesses; and
yet one in essence, as the knowledge of him includes the knowledge of
the Father.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p13">23. Ye are - Again he passes over their interruption, and
proves what he advanced, ver. 21. Of them that are beneath - From the
earth. I am of them that are above - Here he directly shows whence he
came, even from heaven, and whither he goes.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p14">24. If ye believe not that I AM - Here (as in ver. 58) our
Lord claims the Divine name, I AM, <scripRef passage="Exod. iii. 14" id="i.v.ix-p14.1" parsed="|Exod|3|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3.14">Exod. iii, 14</scripRef>. But the Jews, as if he had stopped short, and not finished
the sentence, answered, Who art thou?</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p15">25. Even what I say to you from the beginning - The same
which I say to you, as it were in one discourse, with one even tenor
from the time I first spake to you.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p16">26. I have many things to say and to judge of you - I have
much to say concerning your inexcusable unbelief: but he that sent me is
true - Whether ye believe or no. And I speak the things which I have
heard from him - I deliver truly what he hath given me in charge.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p17">27. They understood not - That by him that sent him he
meant God the Father. Therefore in ver. 28, 29 he speaks plainly of the
Father, and again claims the Divine name, I AM.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p18">28. When ye shall have lifted up - On the cross, ye shall
know - And so many of them did, that I AM - God over all; and that I do
nothing of myself - Being one with the Father.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p19">29. The Father hath not left me alone - Never from the
moment I came into the world.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p20">32. The truth - Written in your hearts by the Spirit of
God, shall make you free - From guilt, sin, misery, Satan.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p21">33. They - The other Jews that were by, (not those that
believed,) as appears by the whole tenor of the conversation. We were
never enslaved to any man - A bold, notorious untruth. At that very time
they were enslaved to the Romans.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p22">34. Jesus answered - Each branch of their objection, first
concerning freedom, then concerning their being Abraham's offspring,
ver. 37, &amp;c. He that committeth sin, is, in fact, the slave of
sin.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p23">35. And the slave abideth not in the house - All sinners
shall be cast out of God's house, as the slave was out of Abraham's: but
I, the Son, abide therein forever.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p24">36. If I therefore make you free, ye - shall partake of the
same privilege: being made free from all guilt and sin, ye shall abide
in the house of God forever.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p25">37. I know that ye are Abraham's offspring - As to the
other branch of your objection, I know that, ye are Abraham's offspring,
after the flesh; but not in a spiritual sense. Ye are not followers of
the faith of Abraham: my word hath no place in your hearts.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p26">41. Ye do the deeds of your father - He is not named yet.
But when they presumed to call God their Father, then he is expressly
called the devil, ver. 44.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p27">42. I proceeded forth - As God, and come - As Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p28">43. Ye cannot - Such is your stubbornness and pride, hear -
Receive, obey my word. Not being desirous to do my will, ye cannot
understand my doctrine, chap. vii, 17.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p29">44. He was a murderer - In inclination, from the beginning
- Of his becoming a devil; and abode not in the truth - Commencing
murderer and liar at the same time. And certainly he was a killer of men
(as the Greek word properly signifies) from the beginning of the world:
for from the very creation he designed and contrived the ruin of men.
When he speaketh a lie, he speaketh of his own - For he is the proper
parent, and, as it were, creator of it. See the origin not only of lies,
but of evil in general!</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p30">45. Because I speak the truth - Which liars hate.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p31">46. Which of you convicteth me of sin? - And is not my life
as unreprovable as my doctrine? Does not my whole behaviour confirm the
truth of what I teach?</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p32">47. He that is of God - That either loves or fears him,
heareth - With joy and reverence, God's words - Which I preach.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p33">48. Say we not well - Have we not just cause to say, Thou
art, a Samaritan - An enemy to our Church and nation; and hast a devil?
-Art possessed by a proud and lying spirit?</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p34">49. I honour my Father - I seek his honour only.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p35">50. I seek not my own glory - That is, as I am the Messiah,
I consult not my own glory. I need not. For my Father consulteth it, and
will pass sentence on you accordingly.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p36">51. If a man keep my word - So will my Father consult my
glory. We keep his doctrine by believing, his promises by hoping, his
command by obeying. He shall never see death - That is, death eternal.
He shall live forever. Hereby he proves that he was no Samaritan; for
the Samaritans in general were Sadducees.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p37">54. If I honour myself - Referring to their words, Whom
makest thou thyself?</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p38">56. He saw it - By faith in types, figures, and promises;
as particularly in Melchisedec; in the appearance of Jehovah to him in
the plains of Mamre, <scripRef passage="Gen. xviii. 1" id="i.v.ix-p38.1" parsed="|Gen|18|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.18.1">Gen. xviii,
1</scripRef>; and in the promise that in his seed all the nations of the
earth shall be blessed. Possibly he had likewise a peculiar Revelation
either of Christ's first or second coming.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p39">57. Thou art not yet fifty years old - At the most. Perhaps
the gravity of our Lord's countenance, together with his afflictions and
labours, might make him appear older than he really was. Hast thou seen
Abraham - Which they justly supposed must have been, if Abraham had seen
him.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p40">58. Before Abraham was I AM - Even from everlasting to
everlasting. This is a direct answer to the objection of the Jews, and
shows how much greater he was than Abraham.</p>

<p id="i.v.ix-p41">59. Then they took up stones - To stone him as a
blasphemer; but Jesus concealed himself - Probably by becoming
invisible; and so passed on - With the same ease as if none had been
there.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="8.19%" prev="i.v.ix" next="i.v.xi" id="i.v.x">
<h3 id="i.v.x-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John IX" id="i.v.x-p0.2" parsed="|John|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.9" /> 

<p id="i.v.x-p1">2. Who sinned, this man or his parents, that he was born
blind? - That is, was it for his own sins, or the sins of his parents?
They suppose (as many of the Jews did, though without any ground from
Scripture) that he might have sinned in a pre-existent state, before he
came into the world.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p2">3. Jesus answered, Neither hath this man sinned, nor his
parents - It was not the manner of our Lord to answer any questions that
were of no use, but to gratify an idle curiosity. Therefore he
determines nothing concerning this. The scope of his answer is, It was
neither for any sins of his own, nor yet of his parents; but that the
power of God might be displayed.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p3">4. The night is coming - Christ is the light. When the
light is withdrawn night comes, when no man can work - No man can do any
thing toward working out his salvation after this life is ended. Yet
Christ can work always. But he was not to work upon earth, only during
the day, or season which was appointed for him.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p4">5. I am the light of the world - I teach men inwardly by my
Spirit, and outwardly by my preaching, what is the will of God; and I
show them, by my example, how they must do it.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p5">6. He anointed the eyes of the blind man with the clay -
This might almost have blinded a man that had sight. But what could it
do toward curing the blind? It reminds us that God is no farther from
the event, when he works either with, or without means, and that all the
creatures are only that which his almighty operation makes them.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p6">7. Go, wash at the pool of Siloam - Perhaps our Lord
intended to make the miracle more taken notice of. For a crowd of people
would naturally gather round him to observe the event of so strange a
prescription, and it is exceeding probable, the guide who must have led
him in traversing a great part of the city, would mention the errand he
was going upon, and so call all those who saw him to a greater
attention. From the fountain of Siloam, which was without the walls of
Jerusalem, a little stream flowed into the city, and was received in a
kind of basin, near the temple, and called the pool of Siloam. Which is,
by interpretation, Sent - And so was a type of the Messiah, who was sent
of God. He went and washed, and came seeing - He believed, and obeyed,
and found a blessing. Had he been wise in his own eyes, and reasoned,
like Naaman, on the impropriety of the means, he had justly been left in
darkness. Lord, may our proud hearts be subdued to the methods of thy
recovering grace! May we leave thee to choose how thou wilt bestow
favours, which it is our highest interest to receive on any terms.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p7">11. A man called Jesus - He seems to have been before
totally ignorant of him.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p8">14. Anointing the eyes - With any kind of medicine on the
Sabbath, was particularly forbidden by the tradition of the elders.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p9">16. This man is not of God - Not sent of God. How can a man
that is a sinner - That is, one living in wilful sin, do such
miracles?</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p10">17. What sayest thou of him, for that he hath opened thine
eyes? - What inference dost thou draw herefrom?</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p11">22. He should be put out of the synagogue - That is be
excommunicated.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p12">27. Are ye also - As well as I, at length convinced and
willing to be his disciples?</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p13">29. We know not whence he is - By what power and authority
he does these things.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p14">30. The man answered - Utterly illiterate as he was. And
with what strength and clearness of reason! So had God opened the eyes
of his understanding, as well as his bodily eyes. Why, herein is a
marvelous thing, that ye - The teachers and guides of the people, should
not know, that a man who has wrought a miracle, the like of which was
never heard of before, must be from heaven, sent by God.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p15">31. We - Even we of the populace, know that God heareth not
sinners - Not impenitent sinners, so as to answer their prayers in this
manner. The honest courage of this man in adhering to the truth, though
he knew the consequence, ver. 22, gives him claim to the title of a
confessor.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p16">33. He could do nothing - Of this kind; nothing
miraculous.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p17">34. Born in sin - And therefore, they supposed, born blind.
They cast him out - Of the synagogue; excommunicated him.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p18">35. Having found him - For he had sought him.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p19">36. Who is he, that I may believe? - This implies some
degree of faith already. He was ready to receive whatever Jesus
said.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p20">37. Lord, I believe - What an excellent spirit was this man
of! Of so deep and strong an understanding; (as he had just shown to the
confusion of the Pharisees,) and yet of so teachable a temper!</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p21">39. For judgment am I come into the world - That is, the
consequence of my coming will be, that by the just judgment of God,
while the blind in body and soul receive their sight, they who boast
they see, will be given up to still greater blindness than before.</p>

<p id="i.v.x-p22">41. If ye had been blind - Invincibly ignorant; if ye had
not had so many means of knowing: ye would have had no sin -
Comparatively to what ye have now. But now ye say - Ye yourselves
acknowledge, Ye see, therefore your sin remaineth - Without excuse,
without remedy.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="8.28%" prev="i.v.x" next="i.v.xii" id="i.v.xi">
<h3 id="i.v.xi-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John X" id="i.v.xi-p0.2" parsed="|John|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.10" /> 

<p id="i.v.xi-p1">1. He that entereth not by the door - By Christ. He is the
only lawful entrance. Into the sheepfold - The Church. He is a thief and
a robber - In God's account. Such were all those teachers, to whom our
Lord had just been speaking.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p2">3. To him the door keeper openeth - Christ is considered as
the shepherd, ver. 11. As the door in the first and following verses.
And as it is not unworthy of Christ to be styled the door, by which both
the sheep and the true pastor enter, so neither is it unworthy of God
the Father to be styled the door keeper. See <scripRef passage="Acts xiv. 27" id="i.v.xi-p2.1" parsed="|Acts|14|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.14.27">Acts xiv, 27</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Colossians iv. 3" id="i.v.xi-p2.2" parsed="|Col|4|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.4.3">Colossians iv, 3</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Rev. iii. 8" id="i.v.xi-p2.3" parsed="|Rev|3|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.3.8">Rev. iii, 8</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Acts xvi. 14" id="i.v.xi-p2.4" parsed="|Acts|16|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.16.14">Acts xvi, 14</scripRef>. And the sheep hear his voice - The circumstances that
follow, exactly agree with the customs of the ancient eastern shepherds.
They called their sheep by name, went before them and the sheep followed
them. So real Christians hear, listen to, understand, and obey the voice
of the shepherd whom Christ hath sent. And he counteth them his own,
dearer than any friend or brother: calleth, advises, directs each by
name, and leadeth them out, in the paths of righteousness, beside the
waters of comfort.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p3">4. He goeth before them - In all the ways of God, teaching
them in every point, by example as well as by precept; and the sheep
follow him - They tread in his steps: for they know his voice - Having
the witness in themselves that his words are the wisdom and the power of
God. Reader, art thou a shepherd of souls? Then answer to God. Is it
thus with thee and thy flock?</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p4">5. They will not follow a stranger - One whom Christ hath
not sent, who doth not answer the preceding description. Him they will
not follow - And who can constrain them to it? But will flee from him -
As from the plague. For they know not the voice of strangers - They
cannot relish it; it is harsh and grating to them. They find nothing of
God therein.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p5">6. They - The Pharisees, to whom our Lord more immediately
spake, as appears from the close of the foregoing chapter.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p6">7. I am the door - Christ is both the Door and the
Shepherd, and all things.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p7">8. Whosoever are come - Independently of me, assuming any
part of my character, pretending, like your elders and rabbis, to a
power over the consciences of men, attempting to make laws in the
Church, and to teach their own traditions as the way of salvation: all
those prophets and expounders of God's word, that enter not by the door
of the sheepfold, but run before I have sent them by my Spirit. Our Lord
seems in particular to speak of those that had undertaken this office
since he began his ministry, are thieves -Stealing temporal profit to
themselves, and robbers - Plundering and murdering the sheep.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p8">9. If any one - As a sheep, enter in by me - Through faith,
he shall be safe - From the wolf, and from those murdering shepherds.
And shall go in and out - Shall continually attend on the shepherds whom
I have sent; and shall find pasture - Food for his soul in all
circumstances.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p9">10. The thief cometh not but to steal, and to kill, and to
destroy - That is, nothing else can be the consequence of a shepherd's
coming, who does not enter in by me.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p10">12. But the hireling - It is not the bare receiving hire,
which denominates a man a hireling: (for the labourer is worthy of his
hire; Jesus Christ himself being the Judge: yea, and the Lord hath
ordained, that they who preach the Gospel, should live of the Gospel:)
but the loving hire: the loving the hire more than the work: the working
for the sake of the hire. He is a hireling, who would not work, were it
not for the hire; to whom this is the great (if not only) motive of
working. O God! If a man who works only for hire is such a wretch, a
mere thief and a robber, what is he who continually takes the hire, and
yet does not work at all? The wolf - signifies any enemy who, by force
or fraud, attacks the Christian's faith, liberty, or life. So the wolf
seizeth and scattereth the flock - He seizeth some, and scattereth the
rest; the two ways of hurting the flock of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p11">13. The hireling fleeth because he is a hireling - Because
he loves the hire, not the sheep.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p12">14. I know my sheep - With a tender regard and special
care: and am known of mine - With a holy confidence and affection.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p13">15. As the Father knoweth me, and I know the Father - With
such a knowledge as implies an inexpressible union: and I lay down my
life - Speaking of the present time. For his whole life was only a going
unto death.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p14">16. I have also other sheep - Which he foreknew; which are
not of this fold - Not of the Jewish Church or nation, but Gentiles. I
must bring them likewise - Into my Church, the general assembly of those
whose names are written in heaven. And there shall be one flock - (Not
one fold, a plain false print) no corrupt or divided flocks remaining.
And one shepherd - Who laid down his life for the sheep, and will leave
no hireling among them. The unity both of the flock and the shepherd
shall be completed in its season. The shepherd shall bring all into one
flock: and the whole flock shall hear the one shepherd.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p15">17. I lay down my life that I may take it again - I
cheerfully die to expiate the sins of men, to the end I may rise again
for their justification.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p16">18. I lay it down of myself - By my own free act and deed.
I have power to lay it down, and I have power to take it again - I have
an original power and right of myself, both to lay it down as a ransom,
and to take it again, after full satisfaction is made, for the sins of
the whole world. This commission have I received of my Father - Which I
readily execute. He chiefly spoke of the Father, before his suffering:
of his own glory, after it. Our Lord's receiving this commission as
mediator is not to be considered as the ground of his power to lay down
and resume his life. For this he had in himself, as having an original
right to dispose thereof, antecedent to the Father's commission. But
this commission was the reason why he thus used his power in laying down
his life. He did it in obedience to his Father.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p17">21. These are not the words - The word in the original
takes in actions too.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p18">22. It was the feast of the dedication - Instituted by
Judas Maccabeus, <scripRef passage="1 Macc. iv. 59" id="i.v.xi-p18.1" parsed="|1Macc|4|59|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Macc.4.59">1 Macc. iv,
59</scripRef>, when he purged and dedicated the altar and temple after
they had been polluted. So our Lord observed festivals even of human
appointment. Is it not, at least, innocent for us to do the same?</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p19">23. In Solomon's portico - Josephus informs us, that when
Solomon built the temple, he filled up a part of the adjacent valley,
and built a portico over it toward the east. This was a noble structure,
supported by a wall four hundred cubits high: and continued even to the
time of Albinus and Agrippa, which was several years after the death of
Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p20">26. Ye do not believe, because ye are not of my sheep -
Because ye do not, will not follow me: because ye are proud, unholy,
lovers of praise, lovers of the world, lovers of pleasure, not of
God.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p21">27, 28, 29. My sheep hear my voice, and I know them, and
they follow me, &amp;c.- Our Lord still alludes to the discourse he had
before this festival. As if he had said, My sheep are they who,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xi-p22">1. Hear my voice by faith;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xi-p23">2. Are known (that is, approved) by me, as
loving me; and</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xi-p24">3. Follow me, keep my commandments, with a
believing, loving heart. And to those who,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.xi-p25">1. Truly believe (observe three promises
annexed to three conditions) I give eternal life. He does not say, I
will, but I give. For he that believeth hath everlasting life. Those
whom,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.xi-p26">2. I know truly to love me, shall never
perish, provided they abide in my love.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.v.xi-p27">3. Those who follow me, neither men nor
devils can pluck out of my hand. My Father who hath, by an unchangeable
decree, given me all that believe, love, and obey, is greater than all
in heaven or earth, and none is able to pluck them out of his hand.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p28">30. I and the Father are one - Not by consent of will only,
but by unity of power, and consequently of nature. Are - This word
confutes Sabellius, proving the plurality of persons: one - This word
confutes Arius, proving the unity of nature in God. Never did any
prophet before, from the beginning of the world, use any one expression
of himself, which could possibly be so interpreted as this and other
expressions were, by all that heard our Lord speak. Therefore if he was
not God he must have been the vilest of men.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p29">34. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxxii. 6" id="i.v.xi-p29.1" parsed="|Ps|82|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.82.6">Psalm lxxxii,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p30">35. If he (God) called them gods unto whom the word of God
came, (that is, to whom God was then speaking,) and the Scripture cannot
be broken - That is, nothing which is written therein can be censured or
rejected.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p31">36. Say ye of him whom the Father hath sanctified, and sent
into the world - This sanctification (whereby he is essentially the Holy
One of God) is mentioned as prior to his mission, and together with it
implies, Christ was God in the highest sense, infinitely superior to
that wherein those Judges were so called.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p32">38. That ye may know and believe - In some a more exact
knowledge precedes, in others it follows faith. I am in the Father and
the Father in me. I and the Father are one - These two sentences
illustrate each other.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p33">40. To the desert place where John baptized, and gave so
honourable a testimony of him.</p>

<p id="i.v.xi-p34">41. John did no miracle - An honour reserved for him, whose
forerunner he was.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="8.44%" prev="i.v.xi" next="i.v.xiii" id="i.v.xii">
<h3 id="i.v.xii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XI" id="i.v.xii-p0.2" parsed="|John|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.11" /> 

<p id="i.v.xii-p1">1. One Lazarus - It is probable, Lazarus was younger than
his sisters. Bethany is named, the town of Mary and Martha, and Lazarus
is mentioned after them, ver. 5. Ecclesiastical history informs us, that
Lazarus was now thirty years old, and that he lived thirty years after
Christ's ascension.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p2">2. It was that Mary who afterward anointed, &amp;c. She was
more known than her elder sister Martha, and as such is named before
her.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p3">4. This sickness is not to death, but for the glory of God
- The event of this sickness will not be death, in the usual sense of
the word, a final separation of his soul and body; but a manifestation
of the glorious power of God.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p4">7. Let us go into Judea - From the country east of Jordan,
whither he had retired some time before, when the Jews sought to stone
him, chap. x, 39, 40.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p5">9. Are there not twelve hours in the day? - The Jews always
divided the space from sunrise to sunset, were the days longer or
shorter, into twelve parts: so that the hours of their day were all the
year the same in number, though much shorter in winter than in summer.
If any man walk in the day he stumbleth not - As if he had said, So
there is such a space, a determined time, which God has allotted me.
During that time I stumble not, amidst all the snares that are laid for
me. Because he seeth the light of this world - And so I see the light of
God surrounding me.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p6">10. But if a man walk in the night - If he have not light
from God; if his providence does no longer protect him.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p7">11. Our friend Lazarus sleepeth - This he spoke, just when
he died. Sleepeth - Such is the death of good men in the language of
heaven. But the disciples did not yet understand this language. And the
slowness of our understanding makes the Scripture often descend to our
barbarous manner of speaking.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p8">16. Thomas in Hebrew, as Didymus in Greek, signifies a
twin. With him - With Jesus, whom he supposed the Jews would kill. It
seems to be the language of despair.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p9">20. Mary sat in the house - Probably not hearing what was
said.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p10">22. Whatsoever thou wilt ask, God will give it thee - So
that she already believed he could raise him from the dead.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p11">25. l am the resurrection - Of the dead. And the life - Of
the living. He that believeth in me, though he die, yet shall he live -
In life everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p12">32. She fell at his feet - This Martha had not done. So she
makes amends for her slowness in coming.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p13">33. He groaned - So he restrained his tears. So he stopped
them soon after, ver. 38. He troubled himself - An expression amazingly
elegant, and full of the highest propriety. For the affections of Jesus
were not properly passions, but voluntary emotions, which were wholly in
his own power. And this tender trouble which he now voluntarily
sustained, was full of the highest order and reason.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p14">35. Jesus wept - Out of sympathy with those who were in
tears all around him, as well as from a deep sense of the misery sin had
brought upon human nature.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p15">37. Could not this person have even caused, that this man
should not have died? - Yet they never dreamed that he could raise him
again! What a strange mixture of faith and unbelief.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p16">38. It was a cave - So Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob, and their
wives, except Rachel, were buried in the cave of Machpelah, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 29-31" id="i.v.xii-p16.1" parsed="|Gen|49|29|49|31" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.29-Gen.49.31">Gen. xlix, 29-31</scripRef>. These caves were commonly in rocks, which abounded in that
country, either hollowed by nature or hewn by art. And the entrance was
shut up with a great stone, which sometimes had a monumental
inscription.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p17">39. Lord, by this time he stinketh - Thus did reason and
faith struggle together.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p18">40. Said I not - It appears by this, that Christ had said
more to Martha than is before recorded.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p19">41. Jesus lifted up his eyes - Not as if he applied to his
Father for assistance. There is not the least show of this. He wrought
the miracle with an air of absolute sovereignty, as the Lord of life and
death. But it was as if he had said, I thank thee, that by the disposal
of thy providence, thou hast granted my desire, in this remarkable
opportunity of exerting my power, and showing forth thy praise.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p20">43. He cried with a loud voice - That all who were present
might hear. Lazarus, come forth - Jesus called him out of the tomb as
easily as if he had been not only alive, but awake also.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p21">44. And he came forth bound hand and foot with grave
clothes - Which were wrapt round each hand and each foot, and his face
was wrapt about with a napkin - If the Jews buried as the Egyptians did,
the face was not covered with it, but it only went round the forehead,
and under the chin; so that he might easily see his way.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p22">45. Many believed on Him - And so the Son of God was
glorified, according to what our Lord had said, ver. 4.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p23">46. But some of them went to the Pharisees - What a
dreadful confirmation of that weighty truth, If they hear not Moses and
the prophets, neither will they be persuaded though one rose from the
dead!</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p24">47. What do we? - What? Believe. Yea, but death yields to
the power of Christ sooner than infidelity.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p25">48. All men will believe - And receive him as the Messiah.
And this will give such umbrage to the Roman that they will come and
subvert both our place - Temple; and nation - Both our Church and state.
Were they really afraid of this? Or was it a fair colour only? Certainly
it was no more. For they could not but know, that he that raised the
dead was able to conquer the Romans.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p26">49. That year - That memorable year, in which Christ was to
die. It was the last and chief of Daniel's seventy weeks, the fortieth
year before the destruction of Jerusalem, and was celebrated for various
causes, in the Jewish history. Therefore that year is so peculiarly
mentioned: Caiaphas was the high priest both before and after it. Ye
know nothing - He reproves their slow deliberations in so clear a
case.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p27">50. It is expedient that one man should die for the people
- So God overruled his tongue, for he spake not of himself, by his own
spirit only, but by the spirit of prophecy. And thus he gave unawares as
clear a testimony to the priestly, as Pilate did to the kingly office of
Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p28">52. But that, he might gather into one - Church, all the
children of God that were scattered abroad - Through all ages and
nations.</p>

<p id="i.v.xii-p29">55. Many went up to purify themselves - That they might
remove all hindrances to their eating the passover.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="8.55%" prev="i.v.xii" next="i.v.xiv" id="i.v.xiii">
<h3 id="i.v.xiii-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XII" id="i.v.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|John|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12" /> 

<p id="i.v.xiii-p1">1. Six days before the passover - Namely, on the Sabbath:
that which was called by the Jews, "The Great Sabbath." This whole week
was anciently termed "The great and holy week." Jesus came - From
Ephraim, chap. xi, 54.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p2">2. It seems Martha was a person of some figure, from the
great respect which was paid to her and her sister, in visits and
condolences on Lazarus' death, as well as from the costly ointment
mentioned in the next verse. And probably it was at their house our Lord
and his disciples lodged, when he returned from Jerusalem to Bethany,
every evening of the last week of his life, upon which he was now
entered.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p3">3. Then Mary, taking a pound of ointment - There were two
persons who poured ointment on Christ. One toward the beginning of his
ministry, at or near Nain, <scripRef passage="Luke vii. 37" id="i.v.xiii-p3.1" parsed="|Luke|7|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.7.37">Luke vii,
37</scripRef>, &amp;c. The other six days before his last passover, at
Bethany; the account of whom is given here, as well as by St. Matthew
and Mark.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p4">7. Against the day of my burial - Which now draws nigh.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p5">10. The chief priests consulted, how to kill Lazarus also -
Here is the plain reason why the other evangelists, who wrote while
Lazarus was living, did not relate his story.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p6">12. The next day - On Sunday. Who were come to the feast -
So that this multitude consisted chiefly of Galileans, not men of
Jerusalem. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 8" id="i.v.xiii-p6.1" parsed="|Matt|21|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.8">Matt. xxi, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p7">13. <scripRef passage="Psalm cxviii. 26" id="i.v.xiii-p7.1" parsed="|Ps|118|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.118.26">Psalm cxviii,
26</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xi. 8" id="i.v.xiii-p7.2" parsed="|Mark|11|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.11.8">Mark xi, 8</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 36" id="i.v.xiii-p7.3" parsed="|Luke|19|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.36">Luke xix, 36</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p8">15. Fear not - For his meekness forbids fear, as well as
the end of his coming. <scripRef passage="Zech. ix. 9" id="i.v.xiii-p8.1" parsed="|Zech|9|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.9.9">Zech. ix,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p9">16. These things his disciples understood not at first -
The design of God's providential dispensations is seldom understood at
first. We ought therefore to believe, though we understand not, and to
give ourselves up to the Divine disposal. The great work of faith is, to
embrace those things which we knew not now, but shall know hereafter.
When he had been glorified - At his ascension.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p10">17. When he called Lazarus out of the tomb - How admirably
does the apostle express, as well the greatness of the miracle, as the
facility with which it was wrought! The easiness of the Scripture style
on the most grand occurrences, is more sublime than all the pomp of
orators.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p11">18. The multitude went to meet him, because they heard -
From those who had seen the miracle. So in a little time both joined
together, to go before and to follow him.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p12">20. Certain Greeks - A prelude of the Gentile Church. That
these were circumcised does not appear. But they came up on purpose to
worship the God of Israel.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p13">21. These came to Philip of Bethsaida in Galilee - Perhaps
they used to lodge there, in their journey to Jerusalem. Or they might
believe, a Galilean would be more ready to serve them herein, than a
Jew. Sir - They spake to him, as to one they were little acquainted
with. We would see Jesus - A modest request. They could scarce expect
that he would now have time to talk with them.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p14">23. The hour is come that the Son of man should be
glorified - With the Father and in the sight of every creature. But he
must suffer first.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p15">24. Unless a grain of wheat die - The late resurrection of
Lazarus gave our Lord a natural occasion of speaking on this subject.
And agreeable to his infinite knowledge, he singles out, from among so
many thousands of seeds, almost the only one that dies in the earth: and
which therefore was an exceeding proper similitude, peculiarly adapted
to the purpose for which he uses it. The like is not to be found in any
other grain, except millet, and the large bean.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p16">25. He that loveth his life - More than the will of God;
shall lose it eternally: and he that hateth his life - In comparison of
the will of God, shall preserve it. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 39" id="i.v.xiii-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|10|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.39">Matt. x, 39</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p17">26. Let him follow me - By hating his life: and where I am
- In heaven. If any man serve me - Thus, him will the Father honour.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p18">27. Now is my soul troubled - He had various foretastes of
his passion. And what shall I say? - Not what shall I choose? For his
heart was fixed in choosing the will of his Father: but he laboured for
utterance. The two following clauses, Save me from this hour - For this
cause I came - Into the world; for the sake of this hour (of suffering)
seem to have glanced through his mind in one moment. But human language
could not so express it.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p19">28. Father, glorify thy name - Whatever I suffer. Now the
trouble was over. I have glorified it - By thy entrance into this hour.
And I will glorify it - By thy passing through it.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p20">29. The multitude who stood and heard - A sound, but not
the distinct words - In the most glorious Revelations there may remain
something obscure, to exercise our faith. Said, It thundered -Thunder
did frequently attend a voice from heaven. Perhaps it did so now.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p21">31. Now - This moment. And from this moment Christ thirsted
more than ever, till his baptism was accomplished. Is the judgment of
this world - That is, now is the judgment given concerning it, whose it
shall be. Now shall the prince of this world - Satan, who had gained
possession of it by sin and death, be cast out -That is, judged,
condemned, cast out of his possession, and out of the bounds of Christ's
kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p22">32. Lifted up from the earth - This is a Hebraism which
signifies dying. Death in general is all that is usually imported. But
our Lord made use of this phrase, rather than others that were
equivalent, because it so well suited the particular manner of his
death. I will draw all men - Gentiles as well as Jews. And those who
follow my drawings, Satan shall not be able to keep.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p23">34. How sayest thou, The Son of man must be lifted up? -
How can these things be reconciled? Very easily. He first dies, and then
abideth forever. Who is this Son of man? - Is he the Christ? <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 4" id="i.v.xiii-p23.1" parsed="|Ps|110|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.4">Psalm cx, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p24">35. Then Jesus said to them - Not answering them directly,
but exhorting them to improve what they had heard already. The light - I
and my doctrine.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p25">36. The children of light - The children of God, wise,
holy, happy.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p26">37. Though he had done so many miracles before them - So
that they could not but see them.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p27">38. The arm of the Lord - The power of God manifested by
Christ, in his preaching, miracles, and work of redemption. <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 1" id="i.v.xiii-p27.1" parsed="|Isa|53|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.1">Isaiah liii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p28">39. Therefore now they could not believe - That is, by the
just judgment of God, for their obstinacy and wilful resistance of the
truth, they were at length so left to the hardness of their hearts, that
neither the miracles nor doctrines of our Lord could make any impression
upon them.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p29">40. <scripRef passage="Isaiah vi. 10" id="i.v.xiii-p29.1" parsed="|Isa|6|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.6.10">Isaiah vi,
10</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 14" id="i.v.xiii-p29.2" parsed="|Matt|13|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.14">Matt. xiii,
14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Acts xxviii. 26" id="i.v.xiii-p29.3" parsed="|Acts|28|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.28.26">Acts xxviii,
26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p30">41. When he saw his glory - Christ's, <scripRef passage="Isaiah vi. 1" id="i.v.xiii-p30.1" parsed="|Isa|6|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.6.1">Isaiah vi, 1</scripRef>, &amp;c. And it is there expressly said to be the glory of
the Lord, Jehovah, the Supreme God.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p31">44. Jesus said with a loud voice - This which follows to
the end of the chapter, is with St. John the epilogue of our Lord's
public discourses, and a kind of recapitulation of them. Believeth not
on me - Not on me alone, but also on him that sent me: because the
Father hath sent the Son, and because he and the Father are one.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p32">45. And he that seeth me - By the eye of faith.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p33">47. I judge him not - Not now: for I am not come to judge
the world. See, Christ came to save even them that finally perish! Even
these are a part of that world, which he lived and died to save.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiii-p34">50. His commandment - Kept, is life everlasting - That is
the way to it, and the beginning of it.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="8.68%" prev="i.v.xiii" next="i.v.xv" id="i.v.xiv">
<h3 id="i.v.xiv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XIII" id="i.v.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|John|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.13" /> 

<p id="i.v.xiv-p1">1. Before the feast - Namely, on Wednesday, in the paschal
week. Having loved his own - His apostles, he loved them to the end - Of
his life.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p2">2. Having now - Probably now first.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p3">3. Jesus knowing - Though conscious of his own greatness,
thus humbled himself.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p4">4. Layeth aside his garments - That part of them which
would have hindered him.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p5">5. Into the basin - A large vessel was usually placed for
this very purpose, wherever the Jews supped.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p6">7. What I do thou knowest not now; but thou shalt know
hereafter - We do not now know perfectly any of his works, either of
creation, providence, or grace. It is enough that we can love and obey
now, and that we shall know hereafter.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p7">8. If I wash thee not - If thou dost not submit to my will,
thou hast no part with me - Thou art not my disciple. In a more general
sense it may mean, If I do not wash thee in my blood, and purify thee by
my Spirit, thou canst have no communion with me, nor any share in the
blessings of my kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p8">9. Lord, not my feet only - How fain would man be wiser
than God! Yet this was well meant, though ignorant earnestness.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p9">10. And so ye, having been already cleansed, need only to
wash your feet - That is, to walk holy and undefiled.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p10">14. Ye ought also to wash one another's feet - And why did
they not? Why do we not read of any one apostle ever washing the feet of
any other? Because they understood the Lord better. They knew he never
designed that this should be literally taken. He designed to teach them
the great lesson of humble love, as well as to confer inward purity upon
them. And hereby he teaches us,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xiv-p11">1. In every possible way to assist each other
in attaining that purity;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xiv-p12">2. To wash each other's feet, by performing
all sorts of good offices to each other, even those of the lowest kind,
when opportunity serves, and the necessity of any calls for them.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p13">16. The servant is not greater than his Lord - Nor
therefore ought to think much of either doing or suffering the same
things.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p14">18. I speak not of you all - When I call you happy, I know
one of you twelve whom I have chosen, will betray me; whereby that
scripture will be fulfilled. <scripRef passage="Psalm xli. 9" id="i.v.xiv-p14.1" parsed="|Ps|41|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.41.9">Psalm xli,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p15">20. And I put my own honour upon you, my ambassadors. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 40" id="i.v.xiv-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|10|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.40">Matt. x, 40</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p16">21. One of you - The speaking thus indefinitely at first
was profitable to them all.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p17">23. There was lying in the bosom of Jesus -- that is,
sitting next to him at table. This phrase only expresses the then
customary posture at meals, where the guests all leaned sidewise on
couches. And each was said to lie in the bosom of him who was placed
next above him. One of the disciples whom Jesus loved - St. John avoids
with great care the expressly naming himself. Perhaps our Lord now gave
him the first proof of his peculiar love, by disclosing this secret to
him.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p18">24. Simon Peter - Behind Jesus, who lay between them.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p19">25. Leaning down, and so asking him privately.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p20">26. Jesus answered - In his ear. So careful was he not to
offend (if it had been possible) even Judas himself. The sop - Which he
took up while he was speaking. He giveth it to Judas - And probably the
other disciples thought Judas peculiarly happy! But when even this
instance of our Lord's tenderness could not move him, then Satan took
full possession.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p21">27. What thou doest, do quickly - This is not a permission,
much less a command. It is only as if he had said, If thou art
determined to do it, why dost thou delay? Hereby showing Judas, that he
could not be hid, and expressing his own readiness to suffer.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p22">28. None knew why he said this - Save John and Judas.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p23">30. He went out - To the chief priests. But he returned
afterward, and was with them when they ate the passover, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 20" id="i.v.xiv-p23.1" parsed="|Matt|26|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.20">Matt. xxvi, 20</scripRef>, though not at the Lord's Supper.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p24">31. Jesus saith - Namely, the next day; on Thursday, in the
morning. Here the scene, as it were, is opened, for the discourse which
is continued in the following chapters. Now - While I speak this, the
Son of man is glorified - Being fully entered into his glorious work of
redemption. This evidently relates to the glory which belongs to his
suffering in so holy and victorious a manner.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p25">33. Ye cannot come - Not yet; being not yet ripe for it. <scripRef passage="John vii. 34" id="i.v.xiv-p25.1" parsed="|John|7|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.7.34">John vii, 34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p26">34. A new commandment - Not new in itself; but new in the
school of Christ: for he had never before taught it them expressly.
Likewise new, as to the degree of it, as I have loved you.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p27">36. Peter saith, Lord, whither goest thou? - St. Peter
seems to have thought, that Christ, being rejected by the Jews, would go
to some other part of the earth to erect his throne, where he might
reign without disturbance, according to the gross notions he had of
Christ's kingdom. Thou canst not follow me now - But Peter would not
believe him. And he did follow him, Chap. xviii, 15. But it was afar
off. And not without great loss.</p>

<p id="i.v.xiv-p28">38. The cock shall not have crowed - That is, cock crowing
shall not be over, till thou hast denied me thrice - His three-fold
denial was thrice foretold; first, at the time mentioned here; secondly,
at that mentioned by St. Luke; lastly, at that recorded by St. Matthew
and Mark.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="8.77%" prev="i.v.xiv" next="i.v.xvi" id="i.v.xv">
<h3 id="i.v.xv-p0.1">XIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XIV" id="i.v.xv-p0.2" parsed="|John|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.14" /> 

<p id="i.v.xv-p1">1. Let not your heart be troubled - At my departure.
Believe - This is the sum of all his discourse, which is urged till they
did believe, Chap. xvi, 30. And then our Lord prays and departs.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p2">2. In my Father's house are many mansions - Enough to
receive both the holy angels, and your predecessors in the faith, and
all that now believe, and a great multitude, which no man can
number.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p3">4. The way - Of faith, holiness, sufferings.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p4">5. Thomas saith - Taking him in a gross sense.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p5">6. To the question concerning the way, he answers, I am the
way. To the question concerning knowledge, he answers, I am the truth.
To the question whither, I am the life. The first is treated of in this
verse; the second, ver. 7-17; the third, xiv, 18, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p6">7. Ye have known - Ye have begun to know him.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p7">10. I am in the Father - The words that I speak, &amp;c. -
That is, I am one with the Father, in essence, in speaking, and in
acting.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p8">11. Believe me - On my own word, because I am God. The
works - This respects not merely the miracles themselves, but his
sovereign, Godlike way of performing them.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p9">12. Greater works than these shall he do - So one apostle
wrought miracles merely by his shadow, <scripRef passage="Acts v. 15" id="i.v.xv-p9.1" parsed="|Acts|5|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.5.15">Acts v, 15</scripRef>; another by handkerchiefs carried from his body, <scripRef passage="Acts xix. 12" id="i.v.xv-p9.2" parsed="|Acts|19|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.19.12">Acts xix,
12</scripRef>; and all spake with various tongues. But the converting one
sinner is a greater work than all these. Because I go to my Father - To
send you the Holy Ghost.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p10">15. If ye love me, keep my commandments - Immediately after
faith he exhorts to love and good works.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p11">16. And I will ask the Father - The 21st verse, ver. 21,
shows the connection between this and the preceding verses. And he will
give you another Comforter - The Greek word signifies also an advocate,
instructer, or encourager. Another - For Christ himself was one. To
remain with you forever - With you, and your followers in faith, to the
end of the world.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p12">17. The Spirit of truth - Who has, reveals, testifies, and
defends the truth as it is in Jesus. Whom the world - All who do not
love or fear God, cannot receive, because it seeth him not - Having no
spiritual senses, no internal eye to discern him; nor consequently
knoweth him. He shall be in you - As a constant guest. Your bodies and
souls shall be temples of the Holy Ghost dwelling in you.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p13">18. I will not leave you orphans - A word that is elegantly
applied to those who have lost any dear friend. I come to you - What was
certainly and speedily to be, our Lord speaks of as if it were
already.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p14">19. But ye see me - That is, ye shall certainly see me.
Because I live, ye shall live also - Because I am the living One in my
Divine nature, and shall rise again in my human nature, and live for
ever in heaven: therefore ye shall live the life of faith and love on
earth, and hereafter the life of glory.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p15">20. At that day - When ye see me after my resurrection; but
more eminently at the day of pentecost.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p16">21. He that hath my commandments - Written in his heart. I
will manifest myself to him - More abundantly.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p17">23. Jesus answered - Because ye love and obey me, and they
do not, therefore I will reveal myself to you, and not to them. My
Father will love him - The more any man loves and obeys, the more God
will love him. And we will come to him, and make our abode with him -
Which implies such a large manifestation of the Divine presence and
love, that the former in justification is as nothing in comparison of
it.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p18">26. In my name - For my sake, in my room, and as my agent.
He will teach you all things - Necessary for you to know. Here is a
clear promise to the apostles, and their successors in the faith, that
the Holy Ghost will teach them all that truth which is needful for their
salvation.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p19">27. Peace I leave with you - Peace in general; peace with
God and with your own consciences. My peace - In particular; that peace
which I enjoy, and which I create, I give - At this instant. Not as the
world giveth - Unsatisfying unsettled, transient; but filling the soul
with constant, even tranquillity. Lord, evermore give us this peace! How
serenely may we pass through the most turbulent scenes of life, when all
is quiet and harmonious within! Thou hast made peace through the blood
of thy cross. May we give all diligence to preserve the inestimable gift
inviolate, till it issue in everlasting peace!</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p20">28. God the Father is greater than I - As he was man. As
God, neither is greater nor less than the other.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p21">29. I have told you - Of my going and return.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p22">30. The prince of this world is coming - To make his grand
assault. But he hath nothing in me - No right, no claim, or power. There
is no guilt in me, to give him power over me; no corruption to take part
with his temptation.</p>

<p id="i.v.xv-p23">31. But I suffer him thus to assault me,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xv-p24">1. Because it is the Father's commission to
me, Chap. x, 18.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xv-p25">2. To convince the world of my love to the
Father, in being obedient unto death, <scripRef passage="Phil. ii. 8" id="i.v.xv-p25.1" parsed="|Phil|2|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.2.8">Phil. ii, 8</scripRef>. Arise, let us go hence - Into the city, to the passover.
All that has been related from Chap. xii, 31, was done and said on
Thursday, without the city. But what follows in the fifteenth,
sixteenth, and seventeenth chapters, was said in the city, on the very
evening of the passover just before he went over the brook Kedron.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="8.86%" prev="i.v.xv" next="i.v.xvii" id="i.v.xvi">
<h3 id="i.v.xvi-p0.1">XV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XV" id="i.v.xvi-p0.2" parsed="|John|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.15" /> 

<p id="i.v.xvi-p1">1. I am the true vine - So the true bread, Chap. vi, 32;
that is, the most excellent.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p2">2. Everyone that beareth fruit, he purifieth - by obeying
the truth, <scripRef passage="1 Pet. i. 22" id="i.v.xvi-p2.1" parsed="|1Pet|1|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.1.22">1 Pet. i, 22</scripRef>; and by inward or outward sufferings, <scripRef passage="Heb. xii. 10, 11" id="i.v.xvi-p2.2" parsed="|Heb|12|10|12|11" osisRef="Bible:Heb.12.10-Heb.12.11">Heb. xii, 10, 11</scripRef>. So purity and fruitfulness help each other. That it may
bear more fruit - For this is one of the noblest rewards God can bestow
on former acts of obedience, to make us yet more holy, and fit for
farther and more eminent service.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p3">3. Ye are clean - All of you, to whom I now speak, are
purged from the guilt and power of sin; by the word - Which, applied by
the Spirit, is the grand instrument of purifying the soul.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p4">4. Abide in me - Ye who are now pure by living faith,
producing all holiness; by which alone ye can be in me.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p5">5. I am the vine, ye are the branches - Our Lord in this
whole passage speaks of no branches but such as are, or at least were
once, united to him by living faith.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p6">6. If any one abide not in me - By living faith; not by
Church communion only. He may thus abide in Christ, and be withered all
the time, and cast into the fire at last. He is cast out - Of the
vineyard, the invisible Church. Therefore he was in it once.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p7">7. If ye abide in me, ye shall ask - Prayers themselves are
a fruit of faith, and they produce more fruit.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p8">8. So shall ye be my disciples - Worthy of the name. To be
a disciple of Christ is both the foundation and height of
Christianity.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p9">9. Abide ye in my love - Keep your place in my affection.
See that ye do not forfeit that invaluable blessing. How needless a
caution, if it were impossible for them not to abide therein?</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p10">10. If ye keep my commandments, ye shall abide in my love -
On these terms, and no other, ye shall remain the objects of my special
affection.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p11">11. That my joy might remain in you - The same joy which I
feel in loving the Father, and keeping his commandments.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p12">12. Your joy will be full, if ye so love one another.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p13">13. Greater love - To his friends. He here speaks of them
only.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p14">14. Ye are my friends, if ye do whatsoever I command you -
On this condition, not otherwise. A thunderbolt for Antinomianism! Who
then dares assert that God's love does not at all depend on man's
works?</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p15">15. All things - Which might be of service to you.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p16">16. Ye - My apostles, have not chosen me, but I have chosen
you - As clearly appears from the sacred history: and appointed you,
that ye may go and bear fruit - I have chosen and appointed you for this
end, that ye may go and convert sinners: and that your fruit may remain
- That the fruit of your labours may remain to the end of the world;
yea, to eternity; that whatsoever ye shall ask - The consequence of your
going and bearing fruit will be, that all your prayers will be
heard.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p17">19. Because ye are not of the world, therefore the world
hateth you - Because your maxims, tempers, actions, are quite opposite
to theirs. For the very same reason must the world in all ages hate
those who are not of the world.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p18">20. <scripRef passage="John xiii. 16" id="i.v.xvi-p18.1" parsed="|John|13|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.13.16">John xiii,
16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 24" id="i.v.xvi-p18.2" parsed="|Matt|10|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.24">Matt. x, 24</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 40" id="i.v.xvi-p18.3" parsed="|Luke|6|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.40">Luke vi, 40</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p19">21. All these things will they do to you, because they know
not him that sent me - And in all ages and nations they who know not God
will, for this cause, hate and persecute those that do.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p20">22. They had not had sin - Not in this respect.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p21">23. He that hateth me - As every unbeliever doth, For as
the love of God is inseparable from faith, so is the hatred of God from
unbelief.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p22">25. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxix. 4" id="i.v.xvi-p22.1" parsed="|Ps|69|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.69.4">Psalm lxix,
4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvi-p23">26. When the Comforter is come, whom I will send from the
Father, the Spirit of truth, who proceedeth from the Father, he shall
testify of me - The Spirit's coming, and being sent by our Lord from the
Father, to testify of him, are personal characters, and plainly
distinguish him from the Father and the Son; and his title as the Spirit
of truth, together with his proceeding from the Father, can agree to
none but a Divine person. And that he proceeds from the Son, as well as
from the Father, may be fairly argued from his being called the Spirit
of Christ, <scripRef passage="1 Pet. i. 11" id="i.v.xvi-p23.1" parsed="|1Pet|1|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.1.11">1 Pet. i, 11</scripRef>; and from his being here said to be sent by Christ from the
Father, as well as sent by the Father in his name.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="8.93%" prev="i.v.xvi" next="i.v.xviii" id="i.v.xvii">
<h3 id="i.v.xvii-p0.1">XVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XVI" id="i.v.xvii-p0.2" parsed="|John|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.16" /> 

<p id="i.v.xvii-p1">2. The time cometh, that whosoever killeth you will think
he doth God service - But, blessed be God, the time is so far past, that
those who bear the name of Christ do not now generally suppose they do
him service by killing each other for a difference in opinion or mode of
worship.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p2">3. They have not known the Father nor me - This is the true
root of persecution in all its forms.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p3">4. I did not tell you these things at the beginning,
because I was with you - To bear the chief shock in my own person, and
to screen you from it.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p4">5. None of you asketh me - Now when it is most seasonable.
Peter did ask this before, Chap. xiii, 36.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p5">7. It is expedient for you - In respect of the Comforter,
ver. 7, &amp;c., and of me, ver. 16, &amp;c., and of the Father, ver.
23, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p6">8. He - Observe his twofold office; toward the world, ver.
8, &amp;c.; toward believers, ver. 12, &amp;c.: will convince - All of
the world - Who do not obstinately resist, by your preaching and
miracles, of sin, and of righteousness, and of judgment - He who is
convinced of sin either accepts the righteousness of Christ, or is
judged with Satan. An abundant accomplishment of this we find in the
Acts of the Apostles.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p7">9. Of sin - Particularly of unbelief, which is the
confluence of all sins, and binds them all down upon us.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p8">10. Of righteousness, because I go to my Father - Which the
Spirit will testify, though ye do not then see me. But I could not go to
him if I were not righteous.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p9">11. The prince of this world is judged - And in consequence
thereof dethroned, deprived of the power he had so long usurped over
men. Yet those who reject the deliverance offered them will remain
slaves of Satan still.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p10">12. I have yet many things to say - Concerning my passion,
death, resurrection, and the consequences of it. These things we have,
not in uncertain traditions, but in the Acts, the Epistles, and the
Revelation. But ye cannot bear them now - Both because of your
littleness of faith, and your immoderate sorrow.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p11">13. When he is come - It is universally allowed that the
Father, Son, and Holy Ghost dwell in all believers. And the internal
agency of the Holy Ghost is generally admitted. That of the Father and
the Son, as represented in this Gospel, deserves our deepest
consideration.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p12">15. All things that the Father hath are mine - Could any
creature say this?</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p13">16. A little while and ye shall not see me - When I am
buried: and again, a little while, and ye shall see me - When I am
risen: because I go to my Father - I die and rise again, in order to
ascend to my Father.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p14">19. Jesus said to them - Preventing their question.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p15">20. Ye will weep and lament - When ye see me dead; but your
sorrow will be turned into joy - When ye see me risen.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p16">22. Ye now therefore have sorrow - This gives us no manner
of authority to assert all believers must come into a state of darkness.
They never need lose either their peace, or love, or the witness that
they are the children of God. They never can lose these, but either
through sin, or ignorance, or vehement temptation, or bodily
disorder.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p17">23. Ye shall not question me about any thing - Which you do
not now understand. You will not need to inquire of me; for you will
know all things clearly. Whatsoever ye shall ask - Knowledge, love, or
any thing else, he will give it - Our Lord here gives us a charte
blanche. Believer, write down what thou wilt. He had said, Chap. xiv,
13, I will do it, where the discourse was of glorifying the Father
through the Son. Here, speaking of the love of the Father to believers,
he saith, He will give it.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p18">24. Hitherto ye have asked nothing in my name - For they
had asked him directly for all they wanted.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p19">26. At that day ye shall ask - For true knowledge begets
prayer. And I say not that I will pray - This in nowise implies that he
will not: it means only, The Father himself now loves you, not only
because of my intercession, but also because of the faith and love which
he hath wrought in you.</p>

<p id="i.v.xvii-p20">30. Thou knowest all things - Even our hearts. Although no
question is asked thee, yet thou answerest the thoughts of every one. By
this we believe that thou camest forth from God - They, as it were, echo
back the words which he had spoken in ver. 27, implying, We believe in
God; we believe also in thee.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="9.01%" prev="i.v.xvii" next="i.v.xix" id="i.v.xviii">
<h3 id="i.v.xviii-p0.1">XVII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XVII" id="i.v.xviii-p0.2" parsed="|John|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.17" /> 

<p id="i.v.xviii-p1">In this chapter our Lord prays,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xviii-p2">1. For himself, ver. 1-5. <scripRef passage="John xvii. 1-5" id="i.v.xviii-p2.1" parsed="|John|17|1|17|5" osisRef="Bible:John.17.1-John.17.5">John xvii, 1-5</scripRef></p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xviii-p3">2. For the apostles, ver. 6-19; <scripRef passage="John xvii. 6-19" id="i.v.xviii-p3.1" parsed="|John|17|6|17|19" osisRef="Bible:John.17.6-John.17.19">John xvii, 6-19</scripRef> and again, ver. 24- 26. <scripRef passage="John xvii. 24-26" id="i.v.xviii-p3.2" parsed="|John|17|24|17|26" osisRef="Bible:John.17.24-John.17.26">John xvii,
24-26</scripRef></p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xviii-p4">3. For all believers, ver. 20-23. <scripRef passage="John xvii. 20-23" id="i.v.xviii-p4.1" parsed="|John|17|20|17|23" osisRef="Bible:John.17.20-John.17.23">John xvii, 20-23</scripRef> And</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xviii-p5">4. For the world, ver. 21-23. <scripRef passage="John xvii. 21-23" id="i.v.xviii-p5.1" parsed="|John|17|21|17|23" osisRef="Bible:John.17.21-John.17.23">John xvii, 21-23</scripRef> In his prayer he comprises all he had said from 
31, and seals, as it were, all he had hitherto done, beholding things
past, present, and to come. This chapter contains the easiest words, and
the deepest sense of any in all the Scripture: yet is here no incoherent
rhapsody, but the whole is closely and exactly connected.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p6">1. Father - This simplicity of appellation highly became
the only- begotten Son of God; to which a believer then makes the
nearest approach, when he is fullest of love and humble confidence. The
hour is come - The appointed time for it; glorify thy Son - The Son
glorified the Father, both before and after his own glorification. When
he speaks to the Father he does not style himself the Son of man.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p7">2. As thou hast given him power over all flesh - This
answers to glorify thy Son. That he may give eternal life, &amp;c.-This
answers to that thy Son may glorify thee. To all whom thou hast given
him - To all believers. This is a clear proof that Christ designed his
sacrifice should avail for all: yea, that all flesh, every man, should
partake of everlasting life. For as the Father had given him power over
all flesh, so he gave himself a ransom for all.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p8">3. To know - By loving, holy faith, thee the only true God
- The only cause and end of all things; not excluding the Son and the
Holy Ghost, no more than the Father is excluded from being Lord, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. viii. 6" id="i.v.xviii-p8.1" parsed="|1Cor|8|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.8.6">1 Cor. viii, 6</scripRef>; but the false gods of the heathens; and Jesus Christ - As
their prophet, priest, and king: this is life eternal - It is both the
way to, and the essence of, everlasting happiness.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p9">4. I have finished the work - Thus have I glorified thee,
laying the foundation of thy kingdom on earth.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p10">5. The glory which I had - He does not say received - He
always had it, till he emptied himself of it in the days of his
flesh.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p11">6. I have manifested thy name - All thy attributes; and in
particular thy paternal relation to believers; to the men whom thou hast
given me - The apostles, and so ver. 12. They were thine - By creation,
and by descent from Abraham. And thou hast given them me - By giving
them faith in what I have spoken. So ver. 9.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p12">7. Now they know that all things - Which I have done and
spoken, are of thee - And consequently right and true.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p13">8. They have received them - By faith.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p14">9. I pray not for the world - Not in these petitions, which
are adapted to the state of believers only. (He prays for the world at
ver. 21, 23, that they may believe - That they may know God hath sent
him.) This no more proves that our Lord did not pray for the world, both
before and afterward, than his praying for the apostles alone, ver.
6-19, proves that he did not pray for them also which shall believe
through their word, ver. 20.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p15">10. All things that are mine are thine, and that are thine
are mine - These are very high and strong expressions, too grand for any
mere creature to use; as implying that all things whatsoever, inclusive
of the Divine nature, perfections, and operations, are the common
property of the Father and the Son. And this is the original ground of
that peculiar property, which both the Father and the Son have in the
persons who were given to Christ as Mediator; according to what is said
in the close of the verse, of his being glorified by them; namely,
believing in him, and so acknowledging his glory.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p16">11. Keep them through thy name - Thy power, mercy, wisdom,
that they may be one - with us and with each other; one body, separate
from the world: as we are - By resemblance to us, though not
equality.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p17">12. Those whom thou hast given me I have guarded, and none
of them is lost, but the son of perdition - So one even of them whom God
had given him is lost. So far was even that decree from being
unchangeable! That the Scripture might be fulfilled - That is, whereby
the Scripture was fulfilled. The son of perdition signifies one that
deservedly perishes; as a son of death, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xii. 5" id="i.v.xviii-p17.1" parsed="|2Sam|12|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.12.5">2 Sam. xii, 5</scripRef>; children of hell, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 15" id="i.v.xviii-p17.2" parsed="|Matt|23|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.15">Matt. xxiii, 15</scripRef>, and children of wrath, <scripRef passage="Eph. ii. 3" id="i.v.xviii-p17.3" parsed="|Eph|2|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.2.3">Eph. ii,
3</scripRef>, signify persons justly obnoxious to death, hell, wrath. <scripRef passage="Psalm cix. 8" id="i.v.xviii-p17.4" parsed="|Ps|109|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.109.8">Psalm cix, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p18">13. In the world - That is, before I leave the world. My
joy - The joy I feel at going to the Father.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p19">15. That thou wouldest take them out of the world - Not
yet: but that thou wouldest keep them from the evil one - Who reigns
therein.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p20">17. Sanctify - Consecrate them by the anointing of thy
Spirit to their office, and perfect them in holiness, by means of thy
word.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p21">19. I sanctify myself - I devote myself as a victim, to be
sacrificed.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p22">20. For them who will believe - In all ages.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p23">21. As thou art in me - This also is to be understood in a
way of similitude, and not of sameness or equality. That the world may
believe - Here Christ prays for the world. Observe the sum of his whole
prayer,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xviii-p24">1. Receive me into thy own and my glory;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xviii-p25">2. Let my apostles share therein;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xviii-p26">3. And all other believers:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xviii-p27">4. And let all the world believe.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p28">22. The glory which thou hast given me, I have given them -
The glory of the only begotten shines in all the sons of God. How great
is the majesty of Christians.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p29">24. Here he returns to the apostles. I will - He asks, as
having a right to be heard, and prays, not as a servant, but a Son: that
they may behold my glory - Herein Is the happiness of heaven, <scripRef passage="1 John iii. 2" id="i.v.xviii-p29.1" parsed="|1John|3|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.3.2">1 John iii, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p30">25. Righteous Father - The admission of believers to God
through Christ, flows even from the justice of God.</p>

<p id="i.v.xviii-p31">26. I have declared to them thy name - Thy new, best name
of love; that the love wherewith thou hast loved me - That thou and thy
love, and I and my love, may be in them - That they may love me with
that love.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="9.11%" prev="i.v.xviii" next="i.v.xx" id="i.v.xix">
<h3 id="i.v.xix-p0.1">XVIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XVIII" id="i.v.xix-p0.2" parsed="|John|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18" /> 

<p id="i.v.xix-p1">1. A garden - Probably belonging to one of his friends. He
might retire to this private place, not only for the advantage of secret
devotion, but also that the people might not be alarmed at his
apprehension, nor attempt, in the first sallies of their zeal, to rescue
him in a tumultuous manner. Kedron was (as the name signifies) a dark
shady valley, on the east side of Jerusalem, between the city and the
Mount of Olives, through which a little brook ran, which took its name
from it. It was this brook, which David, a type of Christ, went over
with the people, weeping in his flight from Absalom. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 30" id="i.v.xix-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|26|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.30">Matt. xxvi, 30</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 26" id="i.v.xix-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|14|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.26">Mark xiv, 26</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 39" id="i.v.xix-p1.3" parsed="|Luke|22|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.39">Luke xxii, 39</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p2">2. <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 43" id="i.v.xix-p2.1" parsed="|Mark|14|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.43">Mark xiv,
43</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 47" id="i.v.xix-p2.2" parsed="|Luke|22|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.47">Luke xxii,
47</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p3">3. A troop of soldiers - A cohort of Roman foot.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p4">6. As soon as he said, I am he, they went backward and fell
to the ground - How amazing is it, that they should renew the assault,
after so sensible an experience both of his power and mercy! But
probably the priests among them might persuade themselves and their
attendants, that this also was done by Beelzebub; and that it was
through the providence of God, not the indulgence of Jesus, that they
received no further damage.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p5">8. If ye seek me, let these (my disciples) go - It was an
eminent instance of his power over the spirits of men, that they so far
obeyed this word, as not to seize even Peter, when he had cut off the
ear of Malchus.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p6">9. <scripRef passage="John xvii. 12" id="i.v.xix-p6.1" parsed="|John|17|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.17.12">John xvii,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p7">10. Then Simon Peter - No other evangelist names him. Nor
could they safely. But St. John, writing after his death, might do it
without any such inconvenience.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p8">13. Annas had been high priest before his son-in-law
Caiaphas. And though he had for some time resigned that office, yet they
paid so much regard to his age and experience, that they brought Christ
to Annas first. But we do not read of any thing remarkable which passed
at the house of Annas; for, which reason, his being carried thither is
omitted by the other evangelists. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 57" id="i.v.xix-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|26|57|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.57">Matt. xxvi, 57</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xiv. 53" id="i.v.xix-p8.2" parsed="|Mark|14|53|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.14.53">Mark xiv, 53</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 54" id="i.v.xix-p8.3" parsed="|Luke|22|54|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.54">Luke xxii, 54</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p9">17. Art thou also - As well as the others, one of this
man's disciples - She does not appear to have asked with any design to
hurt him.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p10">20. I spake openly - As to the manner: continually - As to
the time: in the synagogue and temple - As to the place. In secret have
I said nothing - No point of doctrine which I have not taught in
public.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p11">21. Why askest thou me - Whom thou wilt not believe?</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p12">22. Answerest thou the high priest so? - With so little
reverence?</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p13">24. Now Annas had sent him to Caiaphas - As is implied ver.
13. Bound - Being still bound, ver. 12.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p14">28. They went not into the palace themselves, lest they
should be defiled - By going into a house which was not purged from
leaven, <scripRef passage="Deut. xvi. 4" id="i.v.xix-p14.1" parsed="|Deut|16|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.16.4">Deut. xvi, 4</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 2" id="i.v.xix-p14.2" parsed="|Matt|27|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.2">Matt. xxvii, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 1" id="i.v.xix-p14.3" parsed="|Mark|15|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.1">Mark xv, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 1" id="i.v.xix-p14.4" parsed="|Luke|23|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.1">Luke xxiii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p15">31. It is not lawful for us to put any man to death - The
power of inflicting capital punishment had been taken from them that
very year. So the scepter was departed from Judah, and transferred to
the Romans.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p16">32. Signifying what death he should die - For crucifixion
was not a Jewish, but a Roman punishment. So that had he not been
condemned by the Roman governor, he could not have been crucified. Chap.
iii, 14.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p17">36. My kingdom is not of this world - Is not an external,
but a spiritual kingdom; that I might not be delivered to the Jews -
Which Pilate had already attempted to do, ver. 31, and afterward
actually did, chap. xix, 16.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p18">37. Thou sayest - The truth. To this end was I born -
Speaking of his human origin: his Divine was above Pilate's
comprehension. Yet it is intimated in the following words, I came into
the world, that I might witness to the truth - Which was both declared
to the Jews, and in the process of his passion to the princes of the
Gentiles also. Everyone that is of the truth - That is, a lover of it,
heareth my voice - A universal maxim. Every sincere lover of truth will
hear him, so as to understand and practice what he saith.</p>

<p id="i.v.xix-p19">38. What is truth? - Said Pilate, a courtier; perhaps
meaning what signifies truth? Is that a thing worth hazarding your life
for? So he left him presently, to plead with the Jews for him, looking
upon him as an innocent but weak man.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="9.19%" prev="i.v.xix" next="i.v.xxi" id="i.v.xx">
<h3 id="i.v.xx-p0.1">XIX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XIX" id="i.v.xx-p0.2" parsed="|John|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19" /> 

<p id="i.v.xx-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 26" id="i.v.xx-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|27|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.26">Matt. xxvii,
26</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 15" id="i.v.xx-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|15|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.15">Mark xv,
15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p2">7. By our law he ought to die, because he made himself the
Son of God - Which they understood in the highest sense, and therefore
accounted blasphemy.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p3">8. He was the more afraid - He seems to have been afraid
before of shedding innocent blood.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p4">9. Whence art thou? - That is, whose son art thou?</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p5">11. Thou couldst have no power over me - For I have done
nothing to expose me to the power of any magistrate. Therefore he that
delivered me to thee, namely, Caiaphas, knowing this, is more blamable
than thou.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p6">13. Pilate sat down on the judgment seat - Which was then
without the palace, in a place called, in Greek, the pavement, on
account of a beautiful piece of Mosaic work, with which the floor was
adorned: but in Hebrew, Gabbatha - Or the high place, because it stood
on an eminence, so that the judge sitting on his throne might be seen
and heard by a considerable number of people.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p7">14. It was the preparation of the passover - For this
reason both the Jews and Pilate were desirous to bring the matter to a
conclusion. Every Friday was called the preparation, (namely, for the
Sabbath.) And as often as the passover fell on a Friday, that day was
called the preparation of the passover.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p8">17. Bearing his cross - Not the whole cross, (for that was
too large and heavy,) but the transverse beam of it, to which his hands
were afterward fastened. This they used to make the person to be
executed carry. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 31" id="i.v.xx-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|27|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.31">Matt. xxvii,
31</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 20" id="i.v.xx-p8.2" parsed="|Mark|15|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.20">Mark xv, 20</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 26" id="i.v.xx-p8.3" parsed="|Luke|23|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.26">Luke xxiii, 26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p9">19. Jesus of Nazareth, the king of the Jews - Undoubtedly
these were the very words, although the other evangelists do not express
them at large.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p10">20. It was written in Latin - For the majesty of the Roman
empire; in Hebrew - Because it was the language of the nation; and in
Greek - For the information of the Hellenists, who spoke that language,
and came in great numbers to the feast.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p11">22. What I have written, I have written - That shall
stand.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p12">23. The vesture - The upper garment.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p13">24. They parted my garments among them - No circumstance of
David's life bore any resemblance to this, or to several other passages
in the 22nd Psalm. So that in this scripture, as in some others, the
prophet seems to have been thrown into a preternatural ecstasy, wherein,
personating the Messiah, he spoke barely what the Spirit dictated,
without any regard to himself. <scripRef passage="Psalm xxii. 18" id="i.v.xx-p13.1" parsed="|Ps|22|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.22.18">Psalm
xxii, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p14">25. His mother's sister - But we do not read she had any
brother. She was her father's heir, and as such transmitted the right of
the kingdom of David to Jesus: Mary, the wife of Cleopas - Called
likewise Alpheus, the father, as Mary was the mother of James, and
Joses, and Simon, and Judas.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p15">27. Behold thy mother - To whom thou art now to perform the
part of a son in my place, a peculiar honour which Christ conferred on
him. From that hour - From the time of our Lord's death.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p16">29. A stalk of hyssop - Which in those countries grows
exceeding large and strong. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxix. 21" id="i.v.xx-p16.1" parsed="|Ps|69|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.69.21">Psalm
lxix, 21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p17">30. It is finished - My suffering: the purchase of man's
redemption. He delivered up his spirit - To God, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 50" id="i.v.xx-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|27|50|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.50">Matt. xxvii, 50</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p18">31. Lest the bodies should remain on the cross on the
Sabbath - Which they would have accounted a profanation of any Sabbath,
but of that in particular. For that Sabbath was a great day - Being not
only a Sabbath, but the second day of the feast of unleavened bread
(from whence they reckoned the weeks to pentecost:) and also the day for
presenting and offering the sheaf of new corn: so that it was a treble
solemnity.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p19">34. Forthwith there came out blood and water - It was
strange, seeing he was dead, that blood should come out; more strange,
that water also; and most strange of all, that both should come out
immediately, at one time, and yet distinctly. It was pure and true
water, as well as pure and true blood. The asseveration of the beholder
and testifier of it, shows both the truth and greatness of the miracle
and mystery.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p20">35. His testimony is true - Valid, unexceptionable. And he
knoweth - And his conscience beareth him witness, that he testifieth
this for no other end, than that ye may believe.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p21">36. A bone of it shall not be broken - This was originally
spoken of the paschal lamb, an eminent type of Christ. <scripRef passage="Exod. xii. 46" id="i.v.xx-p21.1" parsed="|Exod|12|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12.46">Exod. xii, 46</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p22">37. They shall look on him whom they have pierced - He was
pierced by the soldier's spear. They who have occasioned his sufferings
by their sins (and who has not?) shall either look upon him in this
world with penitential sorrow: or with terror, when he cometh in the
clouds of heaven, <scripRef passage="Rev. i. 7" id="i.v.xx-p22.1" parsed="|Rev|1|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.1.7">Rev. i, 7</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Zech. xii. 10" id="i.v.xx-p22.2" parsed="|Zech|12|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.12.10">Zech. xii, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p23">38. Joseph of Arimathea asked Pilate - And Nicodemus also
came - Acknowledging Christ, when even his chosen disciples forsook him.
In that extremity Joseph was no longer afraid, Nicodemus no longer
ashamed.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p24">41. In the place where he was crucified - There was a
garden in the same tract of land: but the cross did not stand in the
garden.</p>

<p id="i.v.xx-p25">42. Because of the preparation - That is, they chose the
rather to lay him in that sepulchre which was nigh, because it was the
day before the Sabbath, which also was drawing to an end, so that they
had no time to carry him far.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="9.28%" prev="i.v.xx" next="i.v.xxii" id="i.v.xxi">
<h3 id="i.v.xxi-p0.1">XX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XX" id="i.v.xxi-p0.2" parsed="|John|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20" /> 

<p id="i.v.xxi-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Matt. xxviii. 1" id="i.v.xxi-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|28|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.28.1">Matt. xxviii,
1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark xvi. 1" id="i.v.xxi-p1.2" parsed="|Mark|16|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.16.1">Mark xvi, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 1" id="i.v.xxi-p1.3" parsed="|Luke|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.1">Luke xxiv, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p2">3. Peter went out - Of the city.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p3">6. Peter seeth the linen clothes lie - and the napkin
folded up - The angels who ministered to him when he rose, undoubtedly
folded up the napkin and linen clothes.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p4">8. He saw - That the body was not there, and believed -
That they had taken it away as Mary said.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p5">9. For as yet - They had no thought of his rising
again.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p6">10. They went home - Not seeing what they could do
farther.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p7">11. But Mary stood - With more constancy. <scripRef passage="Mark xvi. 9" id="i.v.xxi-p7.1" parsed="|Mark|16|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.16.9">Mark xvi, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p8">16. Jesus saith to her, Mary - With his usual voice and
accent.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p9">17. Touch me not - Or rather, Do not cling to me (for she
held him by the feet,) <scripRef passage="Matt. xxviii. 9" id="i.v.xxi-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|28|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.28.9">Matt. xxviii,
9</scripRef>. Detain me not now. You will have other opportunities of
conversing with me. For I am not ascended to my Father - I have not yet
left the world. But go immediately to my brethren -- thus does he
intimate in the strongest manner the forgiveness of their fault, even
without ever mentioning it. These exquisite touches, which everywhere
abound in the evangelical writings, show how perfectly Christ knew our
frame. I ascend - He anticipates it in his thoughts, and so speaks of it
as a thing already present. To my Father and your Father, to my God and
your God - This uncommon expression shows that the only- begotten Son
has all kind of fellowship with God. And a fellowship with God the
Father, some way resembling his own, he bestows upon his brethren. Yet
he does not say, Our God: for no creature can be raised to an equality
with him: but my God and your God: intimating that the Father is his in
a singular and incommunicable manner; and ours through him, in such a
kind as a creature is capable of.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p10">19. <scripRef passage="Mark xvi. 14" id="i.v.xxi-p10.1" parsed="|Mark|16|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.16.14">Mark xvi,
14</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 36" id="i.v.xxi-p10.2" parsed="|Luke|24|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.36">Luke xxiv,
36</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p11">21. Peace be unto you - This is the foundation of the
mission of a true Gospel minister, peace in his own soul, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. iv. 1" id="i.v.xxi-p11.1" parsed="|2Cor|4|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.4.1">2 Cor. iv, 1</scripRef>. As the Father hath sent me, so send I you - Christ was the
apostle of the Father, <scripRef passage="Heb. iii. 1" id="i.v.xxi-p11.2" parsed="|Heb|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.3.1">Heb. iii, 1</scripRef>. Peter and the rest, the apostles of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p12">22. He breathed on them - New life and vigour, and saith,
as ye receive this breath out of my mouth, so receive ye the Spirit out
of my fulness: the Holy Ghost influencing you in a peculiar manner, to
fit you for your great embassy. This was an earnest of pentecost.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p13">23. Whosoever sins ye remit - (According to the tenor of
the Gospel, that is, supposing them to repent and believe) they are
remitted, and whosoever sins ye retain (supposing them to remain
impenitent) they are retained. So far is plain. But here arises a
difficulty. Are not the sins of one who truly repents, and unfeignedly
believes in Christ, remitted, without sacerdotal absolution? And are not
the sins of one who does not repent or believe, retained even with it?
What then does this commission imply? Can it imply any more than,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xxi-p14">1. A power of declaring with authority the
Christian terms of pardon; whose sins are remitted and whose retained?
As in our daily form of absolution; and</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.v.xxi-p15">2. A power of inflicting and remitting
ecclesiastical censures? That is, of excluding from, and re-admitting
into, a Christian congregation.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p16">26. After eight days - On the next Sunday.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p17">28. And Thomas said, My Lord and my God - The disciples had
said, We have seen the Lord. Thomas now not only acknowledges him to be
the Lord, as he had done before, and to be risen, as his fellow
disciples had affirmed, but also confesses his Godhead, and that more
explicitly than any other had yet done. And all this he did without
putting his hand upon his side.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p18">30. Jesus wrought many miracles, which are not written in
this book - Of St. John, nor indeed of the other evangelists.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxi-p19">31. But these things are written that ye may believe - That
ye may be confirmed in believing. Faith cometh sometimes by reading;
though ordinarily by hearing.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="9.34%" prev="i.v.xxi" next="i.vi" id="i.v.xxii">
<h3 id="i.v.xxii-p0.1">XXI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="John XXI" id="i.v.xxii-p0.2" parsed="|John|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.21" /> 

<p id="i.v.xxii-p1">2. There were together - At home, in one house.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p2">4. They knew not that it was Jesus - Probably their eyes
were holden.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p3">6. They were not able to draw it for the multitude of
fishes - This was not only a demonstration of the power of our Lord, but
a kind supply for them and their families, and such as might be of
service to them, when they waited afterward in Jerusalem. It was
likewise an emblem of the great success which should attend them as
fishers of men.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p4">7. Peter girt on his upper coat (for he was stript of it
before) - Reverencing the presence of his Lord: and threw himself into
the sea - To swim to him immediately. The love of Christ draws men
through fire and water.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p5">12. Come ye and dine - Our Lord needed not food. And none
presumed - To ask a needless question.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p6">14. The third time - That he appeared to so many of the
apostles together.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p7">15. Simon, son of Jonah - The appellation Christ had given
him, when be made that glorious confession, <scripRef passage="Matt. xvi. 16" id="i.v.xxii-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|16|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.16.16">Matt. xvi, 16</scripRef>, the remembrance of which might make him more deeply
sensible of his late denial of him whom he had so confessed. Lovest thou
me? - Thrice our Lord asks him, who had denied him thrice: more than
these - Thy fellow disciples do? - Peter thought so once, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 33" id="i.v.xxii-p7.2" parsed="|Matt|26|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.33">Matt. xxvi, 33</scripRef>, but he now answers only- I love thee, without adding more
than these. Thou knowest - He had now learnt by sad experience that
Jesus knew his heart. My lambs - The weakest and tenderest of the
flock.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p8">17. Because he said the third time - As if he did not
believe him.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p9">18. When thou art old - He lived about thirty-six years
after this: another shall gird thee - They were tied to the cross till
the nails were driven in; and shall carry thee - With the cross: whither
thou wouldest not - According to nature; to the place where the cross
was set up.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p10">19. By what death he should glorify God - It is not only by
acting, but chiefly by suffering, that the saints glorify God. Follow me
- Showing hereby likewise what death he should die.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p11">20. Peter turning - As he was walking after Christ. Seeth
the disciple whom Jesus loved following him - There is a peculiar spirit
and tenderness in this plain passage. Christ orders St. Peter to follow
him in token of his readiness to be crucified in his cause. St. John
stays not for the call; he rises and follows him too; but says not one
word of his own love or zeal. He chose that the action only should speak
this; and even when he records the circumstance, he tells us not what
that action meant, but with great simplicity relates the fact only. If
here and there a generous heart sees and emulates it, be it so; but he
is not solicitous that men should admire it. It was addressed to his
beloved Master, and it was enough that he understood it.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p12">22. If I will that he tarry - Without dying, till I come -
To judgment. Certainly he did tarry, till Christ came to destroy
Jerusalem. And who can tell, when or how he died? What is that to thee?
- Who art to follow me long before.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p13">23. The brethren -- that is, the Christians. Our Lord
himself taught them that appellation, chap. xx, 17. Yet Jesus did not
say to him, that he should not die - Not expressly. And St. John
himself, at the time of writing his Gospel, seems not to have known
clearly, whether he should die or not.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p14">24. This is the disciple who testifieth - Being still alive
after he had wrote. And we know that his testimony is true - The Church
added these words to St. John's, Gospel, as Tertius did those to St.
Paul's Epistle to the Romans, <scripRef passage="Rom. xvi. 22" id="i.v.xxii-p14.1" parsed="|Rom|16|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.16.22">Rom. xvi,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.v.xxii-p15">25. If they were to be written particularly - Every fact,
and all the circumstances of it. I suppose - This expression, which
softens the hyperbole, shows that St. John wrote this verse.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE ACTS OF THE APOSTLES" progress="9.41%" prev="i.v.xxii" next="i.vi.i" id="i.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts" id="i.vi-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.vi-p0.2">NOTES ON THE ACTS OF THE APOSTLES</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Acts" progress="9.41%" prev="i.vi" next="i.vi.ii" id="i.vi.i">

<p id="i.vi.i-p1">THIS book, in which St. Luke records the actions of the
apostles, particularly of St. Peter and St. Paul, (whose companion in
travel he was,) is as it were the center between the Gospel and the
Epistles. It contains, after a very brief re-capitulation of the
evangelical history, a continuation of the history of Christ, the event
of his predictions, and a kind of supplement to what he had before
spoken to his disciples, by the Holy Ghost now given unto them. It
contains also the seeds, and first stamina of all those things, which
are enlarged upon in the epistles. The Gospels treat of Christ the head.
The Acts show that the same things befell his body; which is animated by
his Spirit, persecuted by the world, defended and exalted by God. In
this book is shown the Christian doctrine, and the method of applying it
to Jews, heathens, and believers; that is, to those who are to be
converted, and those who are converted: the hindrances of it in
particular men, in several kinds of men, in different ranks and nations:
the propagation of the Gospel, and that grand revolution among both Jews
and heathens: the victory thereof, in spite of all opposition, from all
the power, malice, and wisdom of the whole world, spreading from one
chamber into temples, houses, streets, markets, fields, inns, prisons,
camps, courts, chariots, ships, villages, cities, islands: to Jews,
heathens, magistrates, generals, soldiers, eunuchs, captives, slaves,
women, children, sailors: to Athens, and at length to Rome.</p>

<p id="i.vi.i-p2">THE PARTS OF IT ARE SEVEN</p>

<p id="i.vi.i-p3">1. Pentecost, with its antecedents Chap. i-ii</p>

<p id="i.vi.i-p4">2. Transactions w/the Jews, in Jerusalem, in all Judea, and
in Samaria iii-ix</p>

<p id="i.vi.i-p5">3. Transactions at Cesarea, and the reception of the
Gentiles x-xi</p>

<p id="i.vi.i-p6">4. The first course of Barnabas and Paul among the Gentiles
xiii- xiv</p>

<p id="i.vi.i-p7">5. The embassy to, and council at Jerusalem: liberty of the
Gentiles xv</p>

<p id="i.vi.i-p8">6. The second course of St. Paul xvi-xix</p>

<p id="i.vi.i-p9">7. His third, as far as Rom. xix-xxviii</p>
<h2 id="i.vi.i-p9.1">THE ACTS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="9.44%" prev="i.vi.i" next="i.vi.iii" id="i.vi.ii">
<h3 id="i.vi.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts I" id="i.vi.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1" /> 

<p id="i.vi.ii-p1">1. The former treatise - In that important season which
reached from the resurrection of Christ to his ascension, the former
treatise ends, and this begins: this describing the Acts of the Holy
Ghost, (by the apostles,) as that does the acts of Jesus Christ. Of all
things - In a summary manner: which Jesus began to do - until the day -
That is, of all things which Jesus did from the beginning till that
day.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p2">2. After having given commandment - In the 3rd verse St.
Luke expresses in general terms what Christ said to his apostles during
those forty days. But in the 4th and following verses he declares what
he said on the day of his ascension. He had brought his former account
down to that day; and from that day begins the Acts of the Apostles.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p3">3. Being seen by them forty days - That is, many times
during that space. And speaking of the things pertaining to the kingdom
of God - Which was the sum of all his discourses with them before his
passion also.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p4">4. Wait for the promise of the Father, which ye have heard
from me - When he was with them a little before, as it is recorded, <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 49" id="i.vi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Luke|24|49|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.49">Luke xxiv, 49</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p5">5. Ye shall be baptized with the Holy Ghost - And so are
all true believers to the end of the world. But the extraordinary gifts
of the Holy Ghost also are here promised.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p6">6. Dost thou at this time - At the time thou now speakest
of? not many days hence? restore the kingdom to Israel? - They still
seemed to dream of an outward, temporal kingdom, in which the Jews
should have dominion over all nations. It seems they came in a body,
having before concerted the design, to ask when this kingdom would
come.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p7">7. The times or the seasons - Times, in the language of the
Scriptures, denote a longer; seasons, a shorter space. Which the Father
hath put in his own power - To be revealed when and to whom it pleaseth
him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p8">8. But ye shall receive power - and shall be witnesses to
me - That is, ye shall be empowered to witness my Gospel, both by your
preaching and suffering.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p9">12. A Sabbath-day's journey - The Jews generally fix this
to two thousand cubits, which is not a mile.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p10">13. They went up into the upper room - The upper rooms, so
frequently mentioned in Scripture, were chambers in the highest part of
the house, set apart by the Jews for private prayer. These, on account
of their being so retired and convenient, the apostles now used for all
the offices of religion. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 2" id="i.vi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.2">Matt. x,
2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 14" id="i.vi.ii-p10.2" parsed="|Mark|3|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.14">Mark iii, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 13" id="i.vi.ii-p10.3" parsed="|Luke|6|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.13">Luke vi, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p11">14. His brethren -- his near kinsmen, who for some time did
not believe; it seems not till near his death.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p12">15. The number of persons together - Who were together in
the upper room. were a hundred and twenty - But he had undoubtedly many
more in other places; of whom more than five hundred saw him at once
after his resurrection, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. xv. 6" id="i.vi.ii-p12.1" parsed="|1Cor|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.15.6">1 Cor. xv,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p13">16. <scripRef passage="Psalm xli. 9" id="i.vi.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Ps|41|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.41.9">Psalm xli,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p14">18. This man purchased a field with the reward of iniquity
- That is, a field was purchased with the reward of his iniquity; though
very possibly Judas might design the purchase. And falling down on his
face - It seems the rope broke before, or as he died.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p15">19. In their own tongue - This expression, That is, the
field of blood, St. Luke seems to have added to the words of St. Peter,
for the use of Theophilus and other readers who did not understand
Hebrew.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p16">20. His bishopric - That is, his apostleship. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxix. 25" id="i.vi.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Ps|69|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.69.25">Psalm lxix, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p17">21. All the time that the Lord Jesus was going in and out -
That is, conversing familiarly: over us - as our Master. <scripRef passage="Psalm cix. 8" id="i.vi.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Ps|109|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.109.8">Psalm cix, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p18">22. To be a witness with us of his resurrection - And of
the circumstances which preceded and followed it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p19">23. And they appointed two - So far the faithful could go
by consulting together, but no further. Therefore here commenced the
proper use of the lot, whereby a matter of importance, which cannot be
determined by any ordinary method, is committed to the Divine
decision.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ii-p20">25. Fell - By his transgression - Some time before his
death: to go to his own place - That which his crimes had deserved, and
which he had chosen for himself, far from the other apostles, in the
region of death.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="9.52%" prev="i.vi.ii" next="i.vi.iv" id="i.vi.iii">
<h3 id="i.vi.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts II" id="i.vi.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.2" /> 

<p id="i.vi.iii-p1">1. At the pentecost of Sinai, in the Old Testament, and the
pentecost of Jerusalem, in the New, where the two grand manifestations
of God, the legal and the evangelical; the one from the mountain, and
the other from heaven; the terrible, and the merciful one. They were all
with one accord in one place - So here was a conjunction of company,
minds, and place; the whole hundred and twenty being present.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p2">2. And suddenly there came a sound from heaven - So will
the Son of man come to judgment. And it filled all the house - That is,
all that part of the temple where they were sitting.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p3">3. And there appeared distinct tongues, as of fire - That
is, small flames of fire. This is all which the phrase, tongues of fire,
means in the language of the seventy. Yet it might intimate God's
touching their tongues as it were (together with their hearts) with
Divine fire: his giving them such words as were active and penetrating,
even as flaming fire.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p4">4. And they began to speak with other tongues - The miracle
was not in the ears of the hearers, (as some have unaccountably
supposed,) but in the mouth of the speakers. And this family praising
God together, with the tongues of all the world, was an earnest that the
whole world should in due time praise God in their various tongues. As
the Spirit gave them utterance - Moses, the type of the law, was of a
slow tongue; but the Gospel speaks with a fiery and flaming one.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p5">5. And there were dwelling in Jerusalem Jews - Gathered
from all parts by the peculiar providence of God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p6">6. The multitude came together, and were confounded - The
motions of their minds were swift and various.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p7">9. Judea - The dialect of which greatly differed from that
of Galilee. Asia - The country strictly so called.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p8">10. Roman sojourners - Born at Rome, but now living at
Jerusalem. These seem to have come to Jerusalem after those who are
above mentioned. All of them were partly Jews by birth, and partly
proselytes.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p9">11. Cretans - One island seems to be mentioned for all. The
wonderful works of God - Probably those which related to the miracles,
death, resurrection, and ascension of Christ, together with the effusion
of his Spirit, as a fulfilment of his promises, and the glorious
dispensations of Gospel grace.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p10">12. They were all amazed - All the devout men.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p11">13. But others mocking - The world begins with mocking,
thence proceeds to cavilling, chap. iv, 7; to threats, iv, 17; to
imprisoning, chap. v, 18; blows, v, 40; to slaughter, chap. vii, 58.
These mockers appear to have been some of the natives of Judea, and
inhabitants of Jerusalem, (who understood only the dialect of the
country,) by the apostle's immediately directing his discourse to them
in the next verse. They are full of sweet wine - So the Greek word
properly signifies. There was no new wine so early in the year as
pentecost. Thus natural men are wont to ascribe supernatural things to
mere natural causes; and many times as impudently and unskilfully as in
the present case.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p12">14. Then Peter standing up - All the gestures, all the
words of Peter, show the utmost sobriety; lifted up his voice - With
cheerfulness and boldness; and said to them - This discourse has three
parts; each of which, ver. 14, 22, 29, begins with the same appellation,
men: only to the last part he prefixes with more familiarity the
additional word brethren. Men of Judea - That is, ye that are born in
Judea. St. Peter spoke in Hebrew, which they all understood.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p13">15. It is but the third hour of the day - That is, nine in
the morning. And on the solemn festivals the Jews rarely ate or drank
any thing till noon.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p14">16. But this is that which was spoken of by the prophet -
But there is another and better way of accounting for this. <scripRef passage="Joel ii. 28" id="i.vi.iii-p14.1" parsed="|Joel|2|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Joel.2.28">Joel ii, 28</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p15">17. The times of the Messiah are frequently called the last
days, the Gospel being the last dispensation of Divine grace. I will
pour out of my Spirit - Not on the day of pentecost only, upon all flesh
- On persons of every age, sex, and rank. And your young men shall see
visions - In young men the outward sense, are most vigourous, and the
bodily strength is entire, whereby they are best qualified to sustain
the shock which usually attends the visions of God. In old men the
internal senses are most vigourous, suited to divine dreams. Not that
the old are wholly excluded from the former, nor the young from the
latter.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p16">18. And upon my servants - On those who are literally in a
state of servitude.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p17">19. And I will show prodigies in heaven above, and signs on
earth beneath - Great Revelations of grace are usually attended with
great judgments on those who reject it. In heaven - Treated of, ver. 20.
On earth - Described in this verse. Such signs were those mentioned,
ver. 22, before the passion of Christ; which are so mentioned as to
include also those at the very time of the passion and resurrection, at
the destruction of Jerusalem, and at the end of the world. Terrible
indeed were those prodigies in particular which preceded the destruction
of Jerusalem: such as the flaming sword hanging over the city, and the
fiery comet pointing down upon it for a year; the light that shone upon
the temple and the altar in the night, as if it had been noon-day; the
opening of the great and heavy gate of the temple without hands; the
voice heard from the most holy place, Let us depart hence; the
admonition of Jesus the son of Ananus, crying for seven years together,
Woe, woe, woe; the vision of contending armies in the air, and of
entrenchments thrown up against a city there represented; the terrible
thunders and lightnings, and dreadful earthquakes, which every one
considered as portending some great evil: all which, through the
singular providence of God, are particularly recorded by Josephus. Blood
- War and slaughter. Fire - Burnings of houses and towns, involving all
in clouds of smoke.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p18">20. The moon shall be turned into blood - A bloody colour:
before the day of the Lord - Eminently the last day; though not
excluding any other day or season, wherein the Lord shall manifest his
glory, in taking vengeance of his adversaries.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p19">21. But - whosoever shall call on the name of the Lord -
This expression implies the whole of religion, and particularly prayer
uttered in faith; shall be saved - From all those plagues; from sin and
hell.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p20">23. Him, being delivered by the determinate counsel and
foreknowledge of God - The apostle here anticipates an objection, Why
did God suffer such a person to be so treated? Did he not know what
wicked men intended to do? And had he not power to prevent it? Yea. He
knew all that those wicked men intended to do. And he had power to blast
all their designs in a moment. But he did not exert that power, because
he so loved the world! Because it was the determined counsel of his
love, to redeem mankind from eternal death, by the death of his
only-begotten Son.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p21">24. Having loosed the pains of death - The word properly
means, the pains of a woman in travail. As it was not possible that he
should be held under it - Because the Scripture must needs be
fulfilled.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p22">25. <scripRef passage="Psalm xvi. 8" id="i.vi.iii-p22.1" parsed="|Ps|16|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.16.8">Psalm xvi,
8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p23">27. Thou wilt not leave my soul in hades - The invisible
world. But it does not appear, that ever our Lord went into hell. His
soul, when it was separated from the body, did not go thither, but to
paradise, <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 43" id="i.vi.iii-p23.1" parsed="|Luke|23|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.43">Luke xxiii, 43</scripRef>. The meaning is, Thou wilt not leave my soul in its separate
state, nor suffer my body to be corrupted.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p24">28. Thou hast made known to me the ways of life - That is,
Thou hast raised me from the dead. Thou wilt fill me with joy by thy
countenance - When I ascend to thy right hand.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p25">29. The patriarch - A more honourable title than king.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p26">30. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxxix. 4" id="i.vi.iii-p26.1" parsed="|Ps|89|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.89.4">Psalm lxxxix,
4</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p27">32. He foreseeing this, spake of the resurrection Of Christ
- St. Peter argues thus: It is plain, David did not speak this of
himself. Therefore he spake of Christ's rising. But how does that
promise of a kingdom imply his resurrection? Because he did not receive
it before he died, and because his kingdom was to endure forever, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. vii. 13" id="i.vi.iii-p27.1" parsed="|2Sam|7|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.7.13">2 Sam. vii, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p28">33. Being exalted by the right hand of God - By the right
hand; that is, the mighty power of God. Our Lord was exalted at his
ascension to God's right hand in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p29">34. Sit thou on my right hand - In this and the following
verse is an allusion to two ancient customs; one, to the highest honour
that used to be paid to persons by placing them on the right hand, as
Solomon did Bathsheba, when sitting on his throne, <scripRef passage="1 Kings ii. 19" id="i.vi.iii-p29.1" parsed="|1Kgs|2|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.2.19">1 Kings ii, 19</scripRef>; and the other, to the custom of conquerors, who used to
tread on the necks of their vanquished enemies, as a token of their
entire victory and triumph over them.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p30">35. Until I make thine enemies thy footstool - This text is
here quoted with the greatest address, as suggesting in the words of
David, their great prophetic monarch, how certain their own ruin must
be, if they went on to oppose Christ. <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 1" id="i.vi.iii-p30.1" parsed="|Ps|110|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.1">Psalm cx, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p31">36. Lord - Jesus, after his exaltation, is constantly meant
by this word in the New Testament, unless sometimes where it occurs, in
a text quoted from the Old Testament.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p32">37. They said to the apostles, Brethren - They did not
style them so before.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p33">38. Repent - And hereby return to God: be baptized -
Believing in the name of Jesus - And ye shall receive the gift of the
Holy Ghost - See the three-one God clearly proved. See chap. xxvi, 20.
The gift of the Holy Ghost does not mean in this place the power of
speaking with tongues. For the promise of this was not given to all that
were afar off, in distant ages and nations. But rather the constant
fruits of faith, even righteousness, and peace, and joy in the Holy
Ghost. Whomsoever the Lord our God shall call - (Whether they are Jews
or Gentiles) by his word and by his Spirit: and who are not disobedient
to the heavenly calling. But it is observable St. Peter did not yet
understand the very words he spoke.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p34">40. And with many other words did he testify and exhort -
In such an accepted time we should add line upon line, and not leave
off, till the thing is done. Save yourselves from this perverse
generation - Many of whom were probably mocking still.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p35">41. And there were added - To the hundred and twenty.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p36">42. And they continued steadfast - So their daily Church
communion consisted in these four particulars:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.iii-p37">1. Hearing the word;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.iii-p38">2. Having all things common;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.iii-p39">3. Receiving the Lord's Supper;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.iii-p40">4. Prayer. Ye diff'rent sects, who all
declare, Lo here is Christ, and Christ is there; Your stronger proofs
divinely give, And show me where the Christians live!</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p41">43. And fear came upon every soul - Of those who did not
join with them: whereby persecution was prevented, till it was needful
for them.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p42">45. And sold their possessions - Their lands and houses;
and goods - Their movables. And parted them to all as any one had need -
To say the Christians did this only till the destruction of Jerusalem,
is not true; for many did it long after. Not that there was any positive
command for so doing: it needed not; for love constrained them. It was a
natural fruit of that love wherewith each member of the community loved
every other as his own soul. And if the whole Christian Church had
continued in this spirit, this usage must have continued through all
ages. To affirm therefore that Christ did not design it should continue,
is neither more nor less than to affirm, that Christ did not design this
measure of love should continue. I see no proof of this.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p43">46. Continuing daily - breaking the bread - in the Lord's
Supper, as did many Churches for some ages. They partook of their food
with gladness and singleness of heart - They carried the same happy and
holy temper through all their common actions: eating and working with
the same spirit wherewith they prayed and received the Lord's
Supper.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iii-p44">47. The Lord added daily such as were saved - From their
sins: from the guilt and power of them.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="9.72%" prev="i.vi.iii" next="i.vi.v" id="i.vi.iv">
<h3 id="i.vi.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts III" id="i.vi.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.3" /> 

<p id="i.vi.iv-p1">1. The ninth hour - The Jews divided the time from sunrise
to sunset into twelve hours; which were consequently of unequal length
at different times of the year, as the days were longer or shorter. The
third hour therefore was nine in the morning; the ninth, three in the
afternoon; but not exactly. For the third hour was the middle space
between sunrise and noon; which, if the sun rose at five, (the earliest
hour of its rising in that climate,) was half an hour after eight: if at
seven (the latest hour of its rising there) was half an hour after nine.
The chief hours of prayer were the third and ninth; at which seasons the
morning and evening sacrifices were offered, and incense (a kind of
emblem representing prayer) burnt on the golden altar.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p2">2. At the gate of the temple, called Beautiful - This gate
was added by Herod the Great, between the court of the Gentiles and that
of Israel. It was thirty cubits high, and fifteen broad, and made of
Corinthian brass, more pompous in its workmanship and splendour than
those that were covered with silver and gold.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p3">6. Then said Peter, Silver and gold have I none - How
unlike his supposed successor! Can the bishop of Rome either say or do
the same?</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p4">12. Peter answered the people - Who were running together,
and inquiring into the circumstances of the fact.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p5">13. The God of our fathers - This was wisely introduced in
the beginning of his discourse, that it might appear they taught no new
religion, inconsistent with that of Moses, and were far from having the
least design to divert their regards from the God of Israel. Hath
glorified his Son - By this miracle, whom ye delivered up - When God had
given him to you, and when ye ought to have received him as a most
precious treasure, and to have preserved him with all your power.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p6">14. Ye renounced the Holy One - Whom God had marked out as
such; and the Just One - Even in the judgment of Pilate.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p7">16. His name - Himself: his power and love. The faith which
is by him - Of which he is the giver, as well as the object.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p8">17. And now, brethren -- a word full of courtesy and
compassion, I know - He speaks to their heart, that through ignorance ye
did it - which lessened, though it could not take away, the guilt. As
did also your rulers - The prejudice lying from the authority of the
chief priests and elders, he here removes, but with great tenderness. He
does not call them our, but your rulers. For as the Jewish dispensation
ceased at the death of Christ, consequently so did the authority of its
rulers.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p9">18. But God - Who was not ignorant, permitted this which he
had foretold, to bring good out of it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p10">19. Be converted - Be turned from sin and Satan unto God.
See chap. xxvi, 20. But this term, so common in modern writings, very
rarely occurs in Scripture: perhaps not once in the sense we now use it,
for an entire change from vice to holiness. That the times of refreshing
- Wherein God largely bestows his refreshing grace, may come - To you
also. To others they will assuredly come, whether ye repent or no.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p11">20. And he may send - The apostles generally speak of our
Lord's second coming, as being just at hand. Who was before appointed -
Before the foundation of the world.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p12">21. Till the times of the restitution of all things - The
apostle here comprises at once the whole course of the times of the New
Testament, between our Lord's ascension and his coming in glory. The
most eminent of these are the apostolic age, and that of the spotless
Church, which will consist of all the Jews and Gentiles united, after
all persecutions and apostacies are at an end.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p13">22. The Lord shall raise you up a prophet like unto me -
And that in many particulars. Moses instituted the Jewish Church: Christ
instituted the Christian. With the prophesying of Moses was soon joined
the effect, the deliverance of Israel from Egypt: with the prophesying
of Christ that grand effect, the deliverance of his people from sin and
death. Those who could not hear the voice of God, yet desired to hear
that of Moses. Much more do those who are wearied with the law, desire
to hear the voice of Christ. Moses spake to the people all, and only
those things, which God had commanded him: so did Christ. But though he
was like Moses, yet he was infinitely superior to him, in person, as
well as in office. <scripRef passage="Deut. xviii. 15" id="i.vi.iv-p13.1" parsed="|Deut|18|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.18.15">Deut. xviii,
15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p14">23. Every soul who will not hear that prophet, shall be
destroyed from among the people - One cannot imagine a more masterly
address than this, to warn the Jews of the dreadful consequence of their
infidelity, in the very words of their favourite prophet, out of a
pretended zeal for whom they rejected Christ.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p15">24. These days - The days of the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p16">25. Ye are the sons of the prophets and of the covenant -
That in, heirs of the prophecies. To you properly, as the first heirs,
belong the prophecies and the covenant. <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 3" id="i.vi.iv-p16.1" parsed="|Gen|12|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.3">Gen. xii, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.iv-p17">26. To bless you, by turning you from your iniquities -
Which is the great Gospel blessing.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="9.81%" prev="i.vi.iv" next="i.vi.vi" id="i.vi.v">
<h3 id="i.vi.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts IV" id="i.vi.v-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.4" /> 

<p id="i.vi.v-p1">1. And as they were speaking to the people, the priests -
came upon them - So wisely did God order, that they should first bear a
full testimony to the truth in the temple, and then in the great
council; to which they could have had no access, had they not been
brought before it as criminals.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p2">2. The priests being grieved - That the name of Jesus was
preached to the people; especially they were offended at the doctrine of
his resurrection; for as they had put him to death, his rising again
proved him to be the Just One, and so brought his blood upon their
heads. The priests were grieved, lest their office and temple services
should decline, and Christianity take root, through the preaching of the
apostles, and their power of working miracles: the captain of the temple
- Being concerned to prevent all sedition and disorder, the Sadducees -
Being displeased at the overturning of all their doctrines, particularly
with regard to the resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p3">4. The number of the men - Beside women and children, were
about five thousand - So many did our Lord now feed at once with the
bread from heaven!</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p4">5. Rulers, and elders, and scribes - Who were eminent for
power, for wisdom, and for learning.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p5">6. Annas, who had been the high priest, and Caiaphas, who
was so then.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p6">7. By what name - By what authority, have ye done this? -
They seem to speak ambiguously on purpose.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p7">8. Then Peter, filled with the Holy Ghost - That moment.
God moves his instruments, not when they please, but just when he sees
it needful. Ye rulers - He gives them the honour due to their
office.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p8">10. Be it known to you all - Probably the herald of God
proclaimed this with a loud voice. Whom God hath raised from the dead -
They knew in their own consciences that it was so. And though they had
hired the soldiers to tell a most senseless and incredible tale to the
contrary, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxviii. 12, 15" id="i.vi.v-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|28|12|0|0;|Matt|28|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.28.12 Bible:Matt.28.15">Matt. xxviii, 12,
15</scripRef>, yet it is observable, they did not, so far as we can learn,
dare to plead it before Peter and John.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p9">11. <scripRef passage="Psalm cxviii. 22" id="i.vi.v-p9.1" parsed="|Ps|118|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.118.22">Psalm cxviii,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p10">12. There is no other name whereby we must be saved - The
apostle uses a beautiful gradation, from the temporal deliverance which
had been wrought for the poor cripple, by the power of Christ, to that
of a much nobler and more important kind, which is wrought by Christ for
impotent and sinful souls. He therein follows the admirable custom of
his great Lord and Master, who continually took occasion from earthly to
speak of spiritual things.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p11">13. Illiterate and uneducated men - Even by such men
(though not by such only) hath God in all ages caused his word to be
preached before the world.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p12">17. Yet that it spread no farther - For they look upon it
as a mere gangrene. So do all the world upon genuine Christianity. Let
us severely threaten them - Great men, ye do nothing. They have a
greater than you to flee to.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p13">18. They charged them not to speak - Privately; nor teach -
Publicly.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p14">19. Whether it be just to obey you rather than God, judge
ye - Was it not by the same spirit, that Socrates, when they were
condemning him to death, for teaching the people, said, "O ye Athenians,
I embrace and love you; but I will obey God rather than you. And if you
would spare my life on condition I should cease to teach my fellow
citizens, I would die a thousand times rather than accept the
proposal."</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p15">21. They all glorified God - So much wiser were the people
than those who were over them.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p16">24. The sense is, Lord, thou hast all power. And thy word
is fulfilled. Men do rage against thee: but it is in vain.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p17">25. <scripRef passage="Psalm ii. 1" id="i.vi.v-p17.1" parsed="|Ps|2|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.2.1">Psalm ii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p18">27. Whom thou hast anointed - To be king of Israel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p19">28. The sense is, but they could do no more than thou wast
pleased to permit, according to thy determinate counsel, to save mankind
by the sufferings of thy Son. And what was needful for this end, thou
didst before determine to permit to be done.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p20">30. Thou stretchest forth thy hand - Exertest thy
power.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p21">31. They were all filled - Afresh; and spake the word with
boldness - So their petition was granted.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p22">32. And the multitude of them that believed - Every
individual person were of one heart and one soul - Their love, their
hopes, their passions joined: and not so much as one - In so great a
multitude: this was a necessary consequence of that union of heart; said
that aught of the things which he had was his own - It is impossible any
one should, while all were of one soul. So long as that truly Christian
love continued, they could not but have all things common.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p23">33. And great grace - A large measure of the inward power
of the Holy Ghost, was upon them all - Directing all their thoughts,
words, and actions.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p24">34. For neither was there any one among them that wanted -
We may observe, this is added as the proof that great grace was upon
them all. And it was the immediate, necessary consequence of it: yea,
and must be to the end of the world. In all ages and nations, the same
cause, the same degree of grace, could not but in like circumstances
produce the same effect. For whosoever were possessors of houses and
lands sold them - Not that there was any particular command for this;
but there was great grace and great love: of which this was the natural
fruit.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p25">35. And distribution was made - At first by the apostles
themselves, afterward by them whom they appointed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p26">36. A son of consolation - Not only on account of his so
largely assisting the poor with his fortune; but also of those peculiar
gifts of the Spirit, whereby he was so well qualified both to comfort
and to exhort.</p>

<p id="i.vi.v-p27">37. Having an estate - Probably of considerable value. It
is not unlikely that it was in Cyprus. Being a Levite, he had no
portion, no distinct inheritance in Israel.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="9.91%" prev="i.vi.v" next="i.vi.vii" id="i.vi.vi">
<h3 id="i.vi.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts V" id="i.vi.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.5" /> 

<p id="i.vi.vi-p1">1. But a certain man named Ananias - It is certain, not a
believer, for all that believed were of one heart and of one soul:
probably not baptized; but intending now to offer himself for
baptism.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p2">2. And bringing a certain part - As if it had been the
whole: perhaps saying it was so.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p3">3. To lie to the Holy Ghost - Who is in us. And to keep
back - Here was the first instance of it. This was the first attempt to
bring propriety of goods into the Christian Church.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p4">4. While it remained, did it not remain thine? - It is
true, whosoever among the Christians (not one excepted) had houses or
lands, sold them, and laid the price at the feet of the apostles. But it
was in his own choice to be a Christian or not: and consequently either
to sell his land, or keep it. And when it was sold, was it not in thy
power? - For it does not appear that he professed himself a Christian
when he sold it. Why hast thou conceived this thing in thy heart? - So
profanely to dissemble on so solemn an occasion? Thou hast not lied to
men only, but to God also. Hence the Godhead of the Holy Ghost evidently
appears: since lying to him, ver. 3, is lying to God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p5">5. And Ananias fell down and expired - And this severity
was not only just, considering that complication of vain glory,
covetousness, fraud, and impiety, which this action contained: but it
was also wise and gracious, as it would effectually deter any others
from following his example. It was likewise a convincing proof of the
upright conduct of the apostles, in managing the sums with which they
were intrusted; and in general of their Divine mission. For none can
imagine that Peter would have had the assurance to pronounce, and much
less the power to execute such a sentence, if he had been guilty himself
of a fraud of the same kind; or had been belying the Holy Ghost in the
whole of his pretensions to be under his immediate direction.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p6">7. About the space of three hours - How precious a space!
The woman had a longer time for repentance.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p7">8. If ye sold the land for so much - Naming the sum.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p8">10. The Church - This is the first time it is mentioned:
and here is a native specimen of a New Testament Church; which is a
company of men, called by the Gospel, grafted into Christ by baptism,
animated by love, united by all kind of fellowship, and disciplined by
the death of Ananias and Sapphira.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p9">12. And they were all - All the believers.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p10">13. None of the rest - No formalists or hypocrites, durst
join themselves - In an outward show only, like Ananias and
Sapphira.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p11">14. But so much the more were true believers added, because
unbelievers kept at a distance.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p12">17. The high priest - and the sect of the Sadducees - A
goodly company for the priest! He, and these deniers of any angel or
resurrection, were filled with zeal - Angry, bitter, persecuting
zeal.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p13">20. The words of this - That is, these words of life: words
which show the way to life everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p14">23. We found the prison shut - The angel probably had shut
the doors again.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p15">24. They doubted what this should be - They were even at
their wit's end. The world, in persecuting the children of God, entangle
themselves in numberless difficulties.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p16">28. Did not we strictly command you, not to teach? - See
the poor cunning of the enemies of the Gospel. They make laws and
interdicts at their pleasure, which those who obey God cannot but break;
and then take occasion thereby to censure and punish the innocent, as
guilty. Ye would bring the blood of this man upon us - An artful and
invidious word. The apostles did not desire to accuse any man. They
simply declared the naked truth.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p17">29. Then Peter - In the name of all the apostles, said - He
does not now give them the titles of honour, which he did before, chap.
iv, 8; but enters directly upon the subject, and justifies what he had
done. This is, as it were, a continuation of that discourse, but with an
increase of severity.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p18">30. Hath raised up Jesus - Of the seed of David, according
to the promises made to our fathers.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p19">31. Him hath God exalted - From the grave to heaven; to
give repentance - Whereby Jesus is received as a Prince; and forgiveness
of sins - Whereby he is received as a saviour. Hence some infer, that
repentance and faith are as mere gifts as remission of sins. Not so: for
man co-operates in the former, but not in the latter. God alone forgives
sins.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p20">32. And also the Holy Ghost - A much greater witness.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p21">34. But a certain Pharisee - And as such believing the
resurrection of the dead; a doctor, or teacher of the law - That is, a
scribe, and indeed one of the highest rank; had in honour by all the
people - Except the Sadducees; rising up in the council - So God can
raise defenders of his servants, whensoever and wheresoever he
pleases.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p22">36. Before these days - He prudently mentions the facts
first, and then makes the inference.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p23">38. Let them alone - In a cause which is manifestly good,
we should immediately join. In a cause, on the other hand, which is
manifestly evil, we should immediately oppose. But in a sudden, new,
doubtful occurrence, this advice is eminently useful. If this counsel or
this work - He seems to correct himself, as if it were some sudden work,
rather than a counsel or design. And so it was. For the apostles had no
counsel, plan, or design of their own; but were mere instruments in the
hand of God, working just as he led them from day to day.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vi-p24">41. Rejoicing - to suffer shame - This is a sure mark of
the truth, joy in affliction, such is true, deep, pure.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="10.01%" prev="i.vi.vi" next="i.vi.viii" id="i.vi.vii">
<h3 id="i.vi.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts VI" id="i.vi.vii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.6" /> 

<p id="i.vi.vii-p1">1. There arose a murmuring - Here was the first breach made
on those who were before of one heart and of one soul. Partiality crept
in unawares on some; and murmuring on others. Ah Lord! how short a time
did pure, genuine, undefiled Christianity remain in the world! O the
depth! How unsearchable are thy counsels! marvelous are thy ways, O King
of saints! The Hellenists were Jews born out of Palestine. They were so
called, because they used the Greek as their other tongue. In this
partiality of the Hebrews, and murmuring of the Hellenists, were the
needs of a general persecution sown. Did God ever, in any age or
country, withdraw his restraining providence, and let loose the world
upon the Christians, till there was a cause among themselves? Is not an
open, general persecution, always both penal and medicinal? A punishment
of those that will not accept of milder reproofs, as well as a medicine
to heal their sickness? And at the same time a means both of purifying
and strengthening those whose heart is still right with God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vii-p2">2. It is not right that we should leave the word of God and
serve tables - In the first Church, the primary business of apostles,
evangelists, and bishops, was to preach the word of God; the secondary,
to take a kind of paternal care (the Church being then like a family,)
for the food, especially of the poor, the strangers, and the widows.
Afterward, the deacons of both sexes were constituted for this latter
business. And whatever time they had to spare from this, they employed
in works of spiritual mercy. But their proper office was, to take care
of the poor. And when some of them afterward preached the Gospel, they
did this not by virtue of their deaconship, but of another commission,
that of evangelists, which they probably received, not before, but after
they were appointed deacons. And it is not unlikely that others were
chosen deacons, or stewards, in their room, when any of these commenced
evangelists.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vii-p3">3. Of good report - That there may be no room to suspect
them of partiality or injustice. Full of the Holy Ghost and wisdom - For
it is not a light matter to dispense even the temporal goods of the
Church. To do even this well, a large measure both of the gifts and
grace of God is requisite. Whom we will set over this business - It
would have been happy for the Church, had its ordinary ministers in
every age taken the same care to act in concert with the people
committed to their charge, which the apostles themselves, extraordinary
as their office was, did on this and other occasions.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vii-p4">4. We will constantly attend to prayer, and to the ministry
of the word - This is doubtless the proper business of a Christian
bishop: to speak to God in prayer; to men in preaching his word, as an
ambassador for Christ.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vii-p5">5. And they chose - It seems seven Hellenists, as their
names show. And Nicholas a proselyte - To whom the proselytes would the
more readily apply.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vii-p6">7. And the word of God grew - The hindrances being
removed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vii-p7">9. There arose certain of the synagogue which is called -
It was one and the same synagogue which consisted of these several
nations. Saul of Cilicia was doubtless a member of it; whence it is not
at all improbable, that Gamaliel presided over it. Libertines - So they
were styled, whose fathers were once slaves, and afterward made free.
This was the ease of many Jews who had been taken captive by the
Romans.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vii-p8">14. We have heard him say - So they might. But yet the
consequence they drew would not follow.</p>

<p id="i.vi.vii-p9">15. As the face of an angel - Covered with supernatural
lustre. They reckoned his preaching of Jesus to be the Christ was
destroying Moses and the law; and God bears witness to him, with the
same glory as he did to Moses, when he gave the law by him.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="10.07%" prev="i.vi.vii" next="i.vi.ix" id="i.vi.viii">
<h3 id="i.vi.viii-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts VII" id="i.vi.viii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7" /> 

<p id="i.vi.viii-p1">2. And he said - St. Stephen had been accused of blasphemy
against Moses, and even against God; and of speaking against the temple
and the law, threatening that Jesus would destroy the one, and change
the other. In answer to this accusation, rehearsing as it were the
articles of his historical creed, he speaks of God with high reverence,
and a grateful sense of a long series of acts of goodness to the
Israelites, and of Moses with great respect, on account of his important
and honourable employments under God: of the temple with regard, as
being built to the honour of God; yet not with such superstition as the
Jews; putting them in mind, that no temple could comprehend God. And he
was going on, no doubt, when he was interrupted by their clamour, to
speak to the last point, the destruction of the temple, and the change
of the law by Christ. Men, brethren, and fathers, hearken - The sum of
his discourse is this: I acknowledge the glory of God revealed to the
fathers, ver. 2; the calling of Moses, ver. 34, &amp;c.; the dignity of
the law, verses 8, 38, 44; the holiness of this place, verses 7, 45, 47.
And indeed the law is more ancient than the temple; the promise more
ancient than the law. For God showed himself the God of Abraham, Isaac,
Jacob, and their children freely, ver. 2, &amp;c.; 9, &amp;c.;
17,&amp;c.; 32, 34, 35; and they showed faith and obedience to God, ver.
4, 20, &amp;c., 23, particularly by their regard for the law, ver. 8,
and the promised land, ver. 16. Meantime, God never confined his
presence to this one place or to the observers of the law. For he hath
been acceptably worshipped before the law was given, or the temple
built, and out of this land, ver. 2, 9, 33, 44. And that our fathers and
their posterity were not tied down to this land, their various
sojournings, ver. 4, &amp;c.; 14, 29, 44, and exile, ver. 43, show. But
you and your fathers have always been evil, ver. 9; have withstood
Moses, ver. 25, &amp;c., 39, &amp;c.; have despised the land, ver. 39,
forsaken God, ver. 40, &amp;c., superstitiously honoured the temple,
ver. 48, resisted God and his Spirit, ver. 50, killed the prophets and
the Messiah himself, ver. 51, and kept not the law for which ye contend,
ver. 53. Therefore God is not bound to you; much less to you alone. And
truly this solemn testimony of Stephen is most worthy of his character,
as a man full of the Holy Ghost, and of faith and power: in which,
though he does not advance so many regular propositions, contradictory
to those of his adversaries, yet he closely and nervously answers them
all. Nor can we doubt but he would, from these premises, have drawn
inferences touching the destruction of the temple, the abrogation of the
Mosaic law, the punishment of that rebellious people; and above all,
touching Jesus of Nazareth, the true Messiah, had not his discourse been
interrupted by the clamours of the multitude, stopping their ears, and
rushing upon him. Men, brethren, and fathers - All who are here present,
whether ye are my equals in years, or of more advanced age. The word
which in this and in many other places is rendered men is a mere
expletive. The God of glory - The glorious God, appeared to Abraham
before he dwelt in Haran - Therefore Abraham knew God, long before he
was in this land. <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 1" id="i.vi.viii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.1">Gen. xii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p2">3. Which I will show thee - Abraham knew not where he
went.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p3">4. After his father was dead - While Terah lived, Abraham
lived partly with him, partly in Canaan: but after he died, altogether
in Canaan.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p4">5. No, not to set his foot on - For the field mentioned,
ver. 16, he did not receive by a Divine donation, but bought it; even
thereby showing that he was a stranger in the land.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p5">6. <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 13" id="i.vi.viii-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|15|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.13">Gen. xv,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p6">7. They shall serve me - Not the Egyptians.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p7">8. And so he begat Isaac - After the covenant was given, of
which circumcision was the seal. <scripRef passage="Gen. xvii. 10" id="i.vi.viii-p7.1" parsed="|Gen|17|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.17.10">Gen.
xvii, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p8">9. But God was with him - Though he was not in this land. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxvii. 28" id="i.vi.viii-p8.1" parsed="|Gen|37|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.37.28">Gen. xxxvii, 28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p9">12. Sent our fathers first - Without Benjamin.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p10">14. Seventy-five souls - So the seventy interpreters, (whom
St. Stephen follows,) one son and a grandson of Manasseh, and three
children of Ephraim, being added to the seventy persons mentioned <scripRef passage="Gen. xlvi. 27" id="i.vi.viii-p10.1" parsed="|Gen|46|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.46.27">Gen. xlvi, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p11">16. And were carried over to Shechem - It seems that St.
Stephen, rapidly running over so many circumstances of history, has not
leisure (nor was it needful where they were so well known) to recite
them all distinctly. Therefore he here contracts into one, two different
sepulchres, places, and purchases, so as in the former history, to name
the buyer, omitting the seller, in the latter, to name the seller,
omitting the buyer. Abraham bought a burying place of the children of
Heth, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxiii." id="i.vi.viii-p11.1" parsed="|Gen|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.23">Gen. xxiii.</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Gen. xxiii. 1-20" id="i.vi.viii-p11.2" parsed="|Gen|23|1|23|20" osisRef="Bible:Gen.23.1-Gen.23.20">Gen. xxiii,
1-20</scripRef> There Jacob was buried. Jacob bought a field of the children
of Hamor. There Joseph was buried. You see here, how St. Stephen
contracts these two purchases into one. This concise manner of speaking,
strange as it seems to us, was common among the Hebrews; particularly,
when in a case notoriously known, the speaker mentioned but part of the
story, and left the rest, which would have interrupted the current of
his discourse, to be supplied in the mind of the hearer. And laid in the
sepulchre that Abraham bought - The first land which these strangers
bought was for a sepulchre. They sought for a country in heaven. Perhaps
the whole sentence might be rendered thus: So Jacob went down into Egypt
and died, he and our fathers, and were carried over to Shechem, and laid
by the sons (that is, decendants) of Hamor, the father of Shechem, in
the sepulchre that Abraham bought for a sum of money.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p12">17. <scripRef passage="Exod. i. 7" id="i.vi.viii-p12.1" parsed="|Exod|1|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.1.7">Exod. i,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p13">18. Another king - Probably of another family.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p14">19. Exposed - Cast out to perish by hunger or wild
beasts.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p15">20. In which time - A sad but a seasonable time. <scripRef passage="Exod. ii. 2" id="i.vi.viii-p15.1" parsed="|Exod|2|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.2.2">Exod. ii, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p16">21. Pharaoh's daughter took him up - By which means, being
designed for a kingdom, he had all those advantages of education, which
he could not have had, if he had not been exposed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p17">22. In all the wisdom of the Egyptians - Which was then
celebrated in all the world, and for many ages after. And mighty in
words - Deep, solid, weighty, though not of a ready utterance.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p18">23. It came into his heart - Probably by an impulse from
God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p19">24. Seeing one wronged - Probably by one of the task
masters.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p20">25. They understood it not - Such was their stupidity and
sloth; which made him afterward unwilling to go to them.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p21">26. He showed himself - Of his own accord,
unexpectedly.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p22">27. Who appointed thee - "Under the presence of the want of
a call by man, the instruments of God are often rejected."</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p23">30. The angel - The Son of God; as appears from his styling
himself Jehovah. In a flame of fire - Signifying the majesty of God then
present. <scripRef passage="Exod. iii. 2" id="i.vi.viii-p23.1" parsed="|Exod|3|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3.2">Exod. iii, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p24">33. Then said the Lord, Loose thy shoes - An ancient token
of reverence; for the place is holy ground - The holiness of places
depends on the peculiar presence of God there.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p25">35. This Moses whom they refused - Namely, forty years
before. Probably, not they, but their fathers did it, and God imputes it
to them. So God frequently imputes the sins of the fathers to those of
their children who are of the same spirit. Him did God send to be a
deliverer - Which is much more than a judge; by the hand of - That is,
by means of the angel - This angel who spoke to Moses on Mount Sinai
expressly called himself Jehovah, a name which cannot, without the
highest presumption, be assumed by any created angel, since he whose
name alone is Jehovah, is the Most High over all the earth, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxxiii. 18" id="i.vi.viii-p25.1" parsed="|Ps|83|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.83.18">Psalm lxxxiii, 18</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxxiii. 18" id="i.vi.viii-p25.2" parsed="|Ps|83|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.83.18">Psalm lxxxiii, 18</scripRef>. It was therefore the Son of God who delivered the law to
Moses, under the character of Jehovah, and who is here spoken of as the
angel of the covenant, in respect of his mediatorial office.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p26">37. The Lord will raise you up a prophet - St. Stephen here
shows that there is no opposition between Moses and Christ. <scripRef passage="Deut. xviii. 15" id="i.vi.viii-p26.1" parsed="|Deut|18|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.18.15">Deut. xviii, 15</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p27">38. This is he - Moses. With the angel, and with our
fathers - As a mediator between them. Who received the living oracles -
Every period beginning with, And the Lord said unto Moses, is properly
an oracle. But the oracles here intended are chiefly the ten
commandments. These are termed living, because all the word of God,
applied by his Spirit, is living and powerful, <scripRef passage="Heb. iv. 12" id="i.vi.viii-p27.1" parsed="|Heb|4|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.4.12">Heb. iv, 12</scripRef>, enlightening the eyes, rejoicing the heart, converting the
soul, raising the dead. <scripRef passage="Exod. xix. 3" id="i.vi.viii-p27.2" parsed="|Exod|19|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.19.3">Exod. xix, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p28">40. Make us gods to go before us - Back into Egypt. <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxii. 1" id="i.vi.viii-p28.1" parsed="|Exod|32|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.32.1">Exod. xxxii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p29">41. And they made a calf - In imitation of Apis, the
Egyptian god: and rejoiced in the works of their hands - In the God they
had made.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p30">42. God turned - From them in anger; and gave them up -
Frequently from the time of the golden calf, to the time of Amos, and
afterward. The host of heaven - The stars are called an army or host,
because of their number, order, and powerful influence. In the book of
the prophets - Of the twelve prophets, which the Jews always wrote
together in one book. Have ye offered - The passage of Amos referred to,
chap. v, 25, &amp;c., <scripRef passage="Amos v. 25" id="i.vi.viii-p30.1" parsed="|Amos|5|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Amos.5.25">Amos v,
25</scripRef> consists of two parts; of which the former confirms ver. 41,
of the sin of the people; the latter the beginning of ver. 42,
concerning their punishment. Have ye offered to me - They had offered
many sacrifices; but God did not accept them as offered to him, because
they sacrificed to idols also; and did not sacrifice to him with an
upright heart. <scripRef passage="Amos v. 25" id="i.vi.viii-p30.2" parsed="|Amos|5|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Amos.5.25">Amos v, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p31">43. Ye took up - Probably not long after the golden calf:
but secretly; else Moses would have mentioned it. The shrine - A small,
portable chapel, in which was the image of their god. Moloch was the
planet Mars, which they worshipped under a human shape. Remphan, that
is, Saturn, they represented by a star. And I will carry you beyond
Babylon - That is, beyond Damascus (which is the word in Amos) and
Babylon. This was fulfilled by the king of Assyria, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xvii. 6" id="i.vi.viii-p31.1" parsed="|2Kgs|17|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.17.6">2 Kings xvii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p32">44. Our fathers had the tabernacle of the testimony - The
testimony was properly the two tables of stone, on which the ten
commandments were written. Hence the ark which contained them is
frequently called the ark of the testimony; and the whole tabernacle in
this place. The tabernacle of the testimony - according to the model
which he had seen - When he was caught up in the visions of God on the
mount.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p33">45. Which our fathers having received - From their
ancestors; brought into the possession of the Gentiles - Into the land
which the Gentiles possessed before. So that God's favour is not a
necessary consequence of inhabiting this land. All along St. Stephen
intimates two things:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.viii-p34">1. That God always loved good men in every
land:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.viii-p35">2. That he never loved bad men even in this. <scripRef passage="Josh iii. 14" id="i.vi.viii-p35.1" parsed="|Josh|3|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.3.14">Josh iii, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p36">46. Who petitioned to find a habitation for the God of
Jacob - But he did not obtain his petition: for God remained without any
temple till Solomon built him a house. Observe how wisely the word is
chosen with respect to what follows.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p37">48. Yet the Most High inhabiteth not temples made with
hands - As Solomon declared at the very dedication of the temple, <scripRef passage="1 Kings viii. 27" id="i.vi.viii-p37.1" parsed="|1Kgs|8|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.8.27">1 Kings viii, 27</scripRef>. The Most High - Whom as such no building can contain. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxvi. 1" id="i.vi.viii-p37.2" parsed="|Isa|66|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.66.1">Isaiah lxvi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p38">49. What is the place of my rest? - Have I need to
rest?</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p39">51. Ye stiff necked - Not bowing the neck to God's yoke;
and uncircumcised in heart - So they showed themselves, ver. 54; <scripRef passage="Act vii. 54" id="i.vi.viii-p39.1" parsed="|Acts|7|54|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.54">Act vii, 54</scripRef> and ears - As they showed, ver. 57. <scripRef passage="Act vii. 57" id="i.vi.viii-p39.2" parsed="|Acts|7|57|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.57">Act vii, 57</scripRef> So far were they from receiving the word of God into their
hearts, that they would not hear it even with their ears. Ye - And your
fathers, always - As often as ever ye are called, resist the Holy Ghost
- Testifying by the prophets of Jesus, and the whole truth. This is the
sum of what he had shown at large.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p40">53. Who have received the law by the administration of
angels - God, when he gave the law on Mount Sinai, was attended with
thousands of his angels, <scripRef passage="Gal. iii. 19" id="i.vi.viii-p40.1" parsed="|Gal|3|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.3.19">Gal. iii,
19</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Psalm lxviii. 17" id="i.vi.viii-p40.2" parsed="|Ps|68|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.68.17">Psalm lxviii,
17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p41">55. But he looking steadfastly up to heaven, saw the glory
of God - Doubtless he saw such a glorious representation, God
miraculously operating on his imagination, as on Ezekiel's, when he sat
in his house at Babylon, and saw Jerusalem, and seemed to himself
transported thither, chap. viii, 1-4. And probably other martyrs, when
called to suffer the last extremity, have had extraordinary assistance
of some similar kind.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p42">56. I see the Son of man standing - As if it were just
ready to receive him. Otherwise he is said to sit at the right hand of
God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p43">57. They rushed upon him - Before any sentence passed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p44">58. The witnesses laid down their clothes at the feet of a
young man, whose name was Saul - O Saul, couldst thou have believed, if
one had told thee, that thou thyself shouldst be stoned in the same
cause? and shouldst triumph in committing thy soul likewise to that
Jesus whom thou art now blaspheming? His dying prayer reached thee, as
well as many others. And the martyr Stephen, and Saul the persecutor,
(afterward his brother both in faith and martyrdom,) are now joined in
everlasting friendship, and dwell together in the happy company of those
who have made their robes white in the blood of the Lamb.</p>

<p id="i.vi.viii-p45">59. And they stoned Stephen, invoking and saying, Lord
Jesus, receive my spirit - This is the literal translation of the words,
the name of God not being in the original. Nevertheless such a solemn
prayer to Christ, in which a departing soul is thus committed into his
hands, is such an act of worship, as no good man could have paid to a
mere creature; Stephen here worshipping Christ in the very same manner
in which Christ worshipped the Father on the cross.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="10.31%" prev="i.vi.viii" next="i.vi.x" id="i.vi.ix">
<h3 id="i.vi.ix-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts VIII" id="i.vi.ix-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.8" /> 

<p id="i.vi.ix-p1">1. At that time there was great persecution against the
Church - Their adversaries having tasted blood, were the more eager. And
they were all dispersed - Not all the Church: if so, who would have
remained for the apostles to teach, or Saul to persecute? But all the
teachers except the apostles, who, though in the most danger, stayed
with the flock.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p2">2. Devout men - Who feared God more than persecution. And
yet were they not of little faith? Else they would not have made so
great lamentation.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p3">3. Saul made havoc of the Church - Like some furious beast
of prey. So the Greek word properly signifies. Men and women - Regarding
neither age nor sex.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p4">4. Therefore they that were dispersed went everywhere -
These very words are reassumed, after as it were a long parenthesis,
chap. xi, 19, and the thread of the story continued.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p5">5. Stephen - Being taken away, Philip, his next colleague,
(not the apostle,) rises in his place.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p6">9. A certain man - using magic - So there was such a thing
as witchcraft once! In Asia at least, if not in Europe or America.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p7">12. But when they believed - What Philip preached, then
they saw and felt the real power of God, and submitted thereto.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p8">13. And Simon believed - That is, was convinced of the
truth.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p9">14. And the apostles hearing that Samaria - The inhabitants
of that country, had received the word of God - By faith, sent Peter and
John - He that sends must be either superior, or at least equal, to him
that is sent. It follows that the college of the apostles was equal if
not superior to Peter.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p10">15. The Holy Ghost - In his miraculous gifts? Or his
sanctifying graces? Probably in both.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p11">18. Simon offered them money - And hence the procuring any
ministerial function, or ecclesiastical benefice by money, is termed
Simony.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p12">21. Thou hast neither part - By purchase, nor lot - Given
gratis, in this matter - This gift of God. For thy heart is not right
before God - Probably St. Peter discerned this long before he had
declared it; although it does not appear that God gave to any of the
apostles a universal power of discerning the hearts of all they
conversed with; any more than a universal power of healing all the sick
they came near. This we are sure St. Paul had not; though he was not
inferior to the chief of the apostles. Otherwise he would not have
suffered the illness of Epaphroditus to have brought him so near to
death, <scripRef passage="Phil. ii. 25-27" id="i.vi.ix-p12.1" parsed="|Phil|2|25|2|27" osisRef="Bible:Phil.2.25-Phil.2.27">Phil. ii, 25-27</scripRef>; nor have left so useful a fellow labourer as Trophimus sick
at Miletus, <scripRef passage="2 Tim. iv. 20" id="i.vi.ix-p12.2" parsed="|2Tim|4|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.4.20">2 Tim. iv, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p13">22. Repent - if perhaps the thought of thy heart may be
forgiven thee - Without all doubt if he had repented, he would have been
forgiven. The doubt was, whether he would repent. Thou art in the gall
of bitterness - In the highest degree of wickedness, which is
bitterness, that is, misery to the soul; and in the bond of iniquity -
Fast bound therewith.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p14">26. The way which is desert - There were two ways from
Jerusalem to Gaza, one desert, the other through a more populous
country.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p15">27. An eunuch - Chief officers were anciently called
eunuchs, though not always literally such; because such used to be chief
ministers in the eastern courts. Candace, queen of the Ethiopians - So
all the queens of Ethiopia were called.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p16">28. Sitting in his chariot, he read the Prophet Isaiah -
God meeteth those that remember him in his ways. It is good to read,
hear, seek information even in a journey. Why should we not redeem all
our time?</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p17">30. And Philip running to him, said, Understandest thou
what thou readest? - He did not begin about the weather, news, or the
like. In speaking for God, we may frequently come to the point at once,
without circumlocution.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p18">31. He desired Philip to come up and sit with him - Such
was his modesty, and thirst after instruction.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p19">32. The portion of Scripture - By reading that very
chapter, the fifty-third of Isaiah, many Jews, yea, and atheists, have
been converted. Some of them history records. God knoweth them all. <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 7" id="i.vi.ix-p19.1" parsed="|Isa|53|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.7">Isaiah liii, 7</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p20">33. In his humiliation his judgment was taken away - That
is, when he was a man, he had no justice shown him. To take away a
person's judgment, is a proverbial phrase for oppressing him. And who
shall declare, or count his generation - That is, who can number his
seed, <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 10" id="i.vi.ix-p20.1" parsed="|Isa|53|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.10">Isaiah liii, 10</scripRef>; which he hath purchased by laying down his life?</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p21">36. And as they went on the way they came to a certain
water - Thus, even the circumstances of the journey were under the
direction of God. The kingdom of God suits itself to external
circumstances, without any violence, as air yields to all bodies, and
yet pervades all. What hindereth me to be baptized? - Probably he had
been circumcised: otherwise Cornelius would not have been the first
fruits of the Gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p22">38. And they both went down - Out of the chariot. It does
not follow that he was baptized by immersion. The text neither affirms
nor intimates any thing concerning it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p23">39. The Spirit of the Lord caught away Philip - Carried him
away with a miraculous swiftness, without any action or labour of his
own. This had befallen several of the prophets.</p>

<p id="i.vi.ix-p24">40. But Philip was found at Azotus - Probably none saw him,
from his leaving the eunuch, till he was there.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="10.40%" prev="i.vi.ix" next="i.vi.xi" id="i.vi.x">
<h3 id="i.vi.x-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts IX" id="i.vi.x-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.9" /> 

<p id="i.vi.x-p1">1. <scripRef passage="Acts xxii. 3" id="i.vi.x-p1.1" parsed="|Acts|22|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.22.3">Acts xxii,
3</scripRef>, &amp;c.; <scripRef passage="Acts xxvi. 9" id="i.vi.x-p1.2" parsed="|Acts|26|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.26.9">Acts xxvi,
9</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p2">2. Bound - By the connivance, if not authority, of the
governor, under Aretas the king. See <scripRef passage="Acts ix. 14, 24" id="i.vi.x-p2.1" parsed="|Acts|9|14|0|0;|Acts|9|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.9.14 Bible:Acts.9.24">Acts ix, 14, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p3">3. And suddenly - When God suddenly and vehemently attacks
a sinner, it is the highest act of mercy. So Saul, when his rage was
come to the height, is taught not to breathe slaughter. And what was
wanting in time to confirm him in his discipleship, is compensated by
the inexpressible terror he sustained. By his also the suddenly
constituted apostle was guarded against the grand snare into which
novices are apt to fall.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p4">4. He heard a voice - Severe, yet full of grace.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p5">5. To kick against the goads - is a Syriac proverb,
expressing an attempt that brings nothing but pain.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p6">6. It shall be told thee - So God himself sends Saul to be
taught by a man, as the angel does Cornelius, chap. x, 5. Admirable
condescension! that the Lord deals with us by men, like ourselves.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p7">7. The men - stood - Having risen before Saul; for they
also fell to the ground, chap. xxvi, 14. It is probable they all
journeyed on foot. Hearing the noise - But not an articulate voice. And
seeing the light, but not Jesus himself, chap. xxvi, 13, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p8">9. And he was three days - An important season! So long he
seems to have been in the pangs of the new birth. Without sight - By
scales growing over his eyes, to intimate to him the blindness of the
state he had been in, to impress him with a deeper sense of the almighty
power of Christ, and to turn his thoughts inward, while he was less
capable of conversing with outward objects. This was likewise a manifest
token to others, of what had happened to him in his journey, and ought
to have humbled and convinced those bigoted Jews, to whom he had been
sent from the sanhedrim.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p9">11. Behold he is praying - He was shown thus to
Ananias.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p10">12. A man called Ananias - His name also was revealed to
Saul.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p11">13. But he answered - How natural it is to reason against
God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p12">14. All that call on thy name - That is, all
Christians.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p13">15. He is a chosen vessel to bear my name - That is, to
testify of me. It is undeniable, that some men are unconditionally
chosen or elected, to do some works for God</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p14">16. For I - Do thou as thou art commanded. I will take care
of the rest; will show him - In fact, through the whole course of his
ministry. How great things he must suffer - So far will he be now from
persecuting others.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p15">17. The Lord hath sent me - Ananias does not tell Saul all
which Christ had said concerning him. It was not expedient that he
should know yet to how great a dignity he was called.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p16">24. They guarded the gates day and night - That is, the
governor did, at their request, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. xi. 32" id="i.vi.x-p16.1" parsed="|2Cor|11|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.11.32">2 Cor.
xi, 32</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p17">26. And coming to Jerusalem - Three years after, <scripRef passage="Gal. i. 18" id="i.vi.x-p17.1" parsed="|Gal|1|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.1.18">Gal. i, 18</scripRef>. These three years St. Paul passes over, chap. xxii, 17,
likewise.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p18">27. To the apostles - Peter and James, <scripRef passage="Gal. i. 18, 19" id="i.vi.x-p18.1" parsed="|Gal|1|18|1|19" osisRef="Bible:Gal.1.18-Gal.1.19">Gal. i, 18, 19</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Gal. i. 18" id="i.vi.x-p18.2" parsed="|Gal|1|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.1.18">Gal. i, 18</scripRef>,</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p19">19 And declared - He who has been an enemy to the truth
ought not to be trusted till he gives proof that he is changed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p20">31. Then the Church - The whole body of Christian
believers, had peace - Their bitterest persecutor being converted. And
being built up - In holy, loving faith, continually increasing, and
walking in - That is, speaking and acting only from this principle, the
fear of God and the comfort of the Holy Ghost - An excellent mixture of
inward and outward peace, tempered with filial fear.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p21">35. Lydda was a large town, one day's journey from
Jerusalem. It stood in the plain or valley of Sharon, which extended
from Caesarea to Joppa, and was noted for its fruitfulness.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p22">36. Tabitha, which is by interpretation Dorcas - She was
probably a Hellenist Jew, known among the Hebrews by the Syriac name
Tabitha, while the Greeks called her in their own language, Dorcas. They
are both words of the same import, and signify a roe or fawn.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p23">38. The disciples sent to him - Probably none of those at
Joppa had the gift of miracles. Nor is it certain that they expected a
miracle from him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p24">39. While she was with the in - That is, before she
died.</p>

<p id="i.vi.x-p25">40. Peter having put them all out - That he might have the
better opportunity of wrestling with God in prayer, said, Tabitha,
arise. And she opened her eyes, and seeing Peter, sat up - Who can
imagine the surprise of Dorcas, when called back to life? Or of her
friends, when they saw her alive? For the sake of themselves, and of the
poor, there was cause of rejoicing, and much more, for such a
confirmation of the Gospel. Yet to herself it was matter of resignation,
not joy, to be called back to these scenes of vanity: but doubtless, her
remaining days were still more zealously spent in the service of her
saviour and her God. Thus was a richer treasure laid up for her in
heaven, and she afterward returned to a more exceeding weight of glory,
than that from which so astonishing a providence had recalled her for a
season.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="10.49%" prev="i.vi.x" next="i.vi.xii" id="i.vi.xi">
<h3 id="i.vi.xi-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts X" id="i.vi.xi-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.10" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xi-p1">1. And there was a certain man - The first fruits of the
Gentiles, in Cesarea - Where Philip had been before, chap. viii, 40; so
that the doctrine of salvation by faith in Jesus was not unknown there.
Cesarea was the seat of the civil government, as Jerusalem was of the
ecclesiastical. It is observable, that the Gospel made its way first
through the metropolitan cities. So it first seized Jerusalem and
Cesarea: afterward Philippi, Athens, Corinth, Ephesus, Rome itself. A
centurion, or captain, of that called the Italian band - That is, troop
or company.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p2">2. Who gave much alms to the people - That is, to the Jews,
many of whom were at that time extremely poor.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p3">3. He saw in a vision - Not in a trance, like Peter:
plainly, so as to leave one not accustomed to things of this kind no
room to suspect any imposition.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p4">4. Thy prayers and thine alms are come up for a memorial
before God - Dare any man say, These were only splendid sins? Or that
they were an abomination before God? And yet it is certain, in the
Christian sense Cornelius was then an unbeliever. He had not then faith
in Christ. So certain it is, that every one who seeks faith in Christ,
should seek it in prayer, and doing good to all men: though in
strictness what is not exactly according to the Divine rule must stand
in need of Divine favour and indulgence.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p5">8. A devout soldier - How many such attendants have our
modern officers? A devout soldier would now be looked upon as little
better than a deserter from his colours.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p6">10. And he became very hungry - At the usual meal time. The
symbols in visions and trances, it is easy to observe, are generally
suited to the state of the natural faculties.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p7">11. Tied at the corners - Not all in one knot, but each
fastened as it were up to heaven.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p8">14. But Peter said, In nowise, Lord - When God commands a
strange or seemingly improper thing, the first objection frequently
finds pardon. But it ought not to be repeated. This doubt and delay of
St. Peter had several good effects. Hereby the will of God in this
important point was made more evident and incontestable. And Peter also,
having been so slow of belief himself, could the more easily bear the
doubting of his brethren, chap. xi, 2, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p9">15. What God hath purified - Hath made and declared clean.
Nothing but what is clean can come down from heaven. St. Peter well
remembered this saying in the council at Jerusalem, chap. xv, 9.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p10">16. This was done thrice - To make the deeper
impression.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p11">17. While Peter doubted in himself, behold the men -
Frequently the things which befall us within and from without at the
same time, are a key to each other. The things which thus concur and
agree together, ought to be diligently attended to.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p12">19. Behold three men seek thee, arise therefore and go
down, and go with them, doubting nothing - How gradually was St. Peter
prepared to receive this new admonition of the Spirit! Thus God is went
to lead on his children by degrees, always giving them light for the
present hour.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p13">24. Cornelius was waiting for them - Not engaging himself
in any secular business during that solemn time, but being altogether
intent on this one thing.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p14">26. I myself also am a man - And not God, who alone ought
to be worshipped, <scripRef passage="Matt. iv. 10" id="i.vi.xi-p14.1" parsed="|Matt|4|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4.10">Matt. iv,
10</scripRef>. Have all his pretended successors attended to this?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p15">28. But God hath showed me - He speaks sparingly to them of
his former doubt, and his late vision.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p16">29. I ask for what intent ye have sent for me? - St. Peter
knew this already. But he puts Cornelius on telling the story, both that
the rest might be informed, and Cornelius himself more impressed by the
narration: the repetition of which, even as we read it, gives a new
dignity and spirit to Peter's succeeding discourse,</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p17">30. Four days ago I was fasting - The first of these days
he had the vision; the second his messengers came to Joppa; on the
third, St. Peter set out; and on the fourth, came to Cesarea.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p18">31. Thy prayer is heard - Doubtless he had been praying for
instruction, how to worship God in the most acceptable manner.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p19">33. Now therefore we are all present before God - The
language of every truly Christian congregation.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p20">34. I perceive of a truth - More clearly than ever, from
such a concurrence of circumstances. That God is not a respecter of
persons - Is not partial in his love. The words mean, in a particular
sense, that he does not confine his love to one nation; in a general,
that he is loving to every man, and willeth all men should be saved.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p21">35. But in every nation he that feareth God and worketh
righteousness - He that, first, reverences God, as great, wise, good,
the cause, end, and governor of all things; and secondly, from this
awful regard to him, not only avoids all known evil, but endeavours,
according to the best light he has, to do all things well; is accepted
of him - Through Christ, though he knows him not. The assertion is
express, and admits of no exception. He is in the favour of God, whether
enjoying his written word and ordinances or not. Nevertheless the
addition of these is an unspeakable blessing to those who were before in
some measure accepted. Otherwise God would never have sent an angel from
heaven to direct Cornelius to St. Peter.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p22">36. This is the word which God sent - When he sent his Son
into the world, preaching - Proclaiming by him-peace between God and
man, whether Jew or Gentile, by the God-man. He is Lord of both; yea,
Lord of and over all.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p23">37. Ye know the word which was published - You know the
facts in general, the meaning of which I shall now more particularly
explain and confirm to you. The baptism which John preached - To which
he invited them by his preaching, in token of their repentance. This
began in Galilee, which is near Cesarea.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p24">38. How God anointed Jesus - Particularly at his baptism,
thereby inaugurating him to his office: with the Holy Ghost and with
power - It is worthy our remark, that frequently when the Holy Ghost is
mentioned there is added a word particularly adapted to the present
circumstance. So the deacons were to be full of the Holy Ghost and
wisdom, chap. vi, 3. Barnabas was full of the Holy Ghost and faith,
chap. xi, 24. The disciples were filled with joy, and with the Holy
Ghost, chap. xiii, 52. And here, where his mighty works are mentioned,
Christ himself is said to be anointed with the Holy Ghost and with
power. For God was with him-He speaks sparingly here of the majesty of
Christ, as considering the state of his hearers.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p25">41. Not now to all the people - As before his death; to us
who did eat and drink with him - That is, conversed familiarly and
continually with him, in the time of his ministry.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p26">42. It is he who is ordained by God the Judge of the living
and the dead - Of all men, whether they are alive at his coming, or had
died before it. This was declaring to them, in the strongest terms, how
entirely their happiness depended on a timely and humble subjection to
him who was to be their final Judge.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p27">43. To him give all the prophets witness - Speaking to
heathens he does not quote any in particular; that every one who
believeth in him - Whether he be Jew or Gentile; receiveth remission of
sins - Though he had not before either feared God, or worked
righteousness.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p28">44. The Holy Ghost fell on all that were hearing the word -
Thus were they consecrated to God, as the first fruits of the Gentiles.
And thus did God give a clear and satisfactory evidence, that he had
accepted them as well as the Jews.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p29">45. The believers of the circumcision - The believing
Jews.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p30">47. Can any man forbid water, that these should not be
baptized, who have received the Holy Ghost? - He does not say they have
the baptism of the Spirit; therefore they do not need baptism with
water. But just the contrary: if they have received the Spirit, then
baptize them with water. How easily is this question decided, if we will
take the word of God for our rule! Either men have received the Holy
Ghost or not. If they have not, Repent, saith God, and be baptized, and
ye shall receive the gift of the Holy Ghost. If they have, if they are
already baptized with the Holy Ghost, then who can forbid water?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xi-p31">48. In the name of the Lord - Which implies the Father who
anointed him, and the Spirit with which he was anointed to his office.
But as the Gentiles had before believed in God the Father, and could not
but now believe in the Holy Ghost, under whose powerful influence they
were at this very time, there was the less need of taking notice, that
they were baptized into the belief and profession of the sacred Three:
though doubtless the apostle administered the ordinances in that very
form which Christ himself had prescribed.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="10.64%" prev="i.vi.xi" next="i.vi.xiii" id="i.vi.xii">
<h3 id="i.vi.xii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XI" id="i.vi.xii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.11" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xii-p1">4. Peter laid all things before them - So he did not take
it ill to be questioned, nor desire to be treated as infallible. And he
answers the more mildly because it related to a point which he had not
readily believed himself.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p2">5. Being in a trance - Which suspends the use of the
outward senses.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p3">14. Saved - With the full Christian salvation, in this
world and the world to come.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p4">17. To us, when we believed - The sense is, because we
believed, not because we were circumcised, was the Holy Ghost given to
us. What was I - A mere instrument in God's hand. They had inquired only
concerning his eating with the Gentiles. He satisfies them likewise
concerning his baptizing them, and shows that he had done right in going
to Cornelius, not only by the command of God, but also by the event, the
descent of the Holy Ghost. And who are we that we should withstand God?
Particularly by laying down rules of Christian communion which exclude
any whom he has admitted into the Church of the first born, from
worshipping God together. O that all Church governors would consider how
bold an usurpation this is on the authority of the supreme Lord of the
Church! O that the sin of thus withstanding God may not be laid to the
charge of those, who perhaps with a good intention, but in an over
fondness for their own forms, have done it, and are continually doing
it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p5">18. They glorified God - Being thoroughly satisfied.
Repentance unto life - True repentance is a change from spiritual death
to spiritual life, and leads to life everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p6">19. They who had been dispersed - St. Luke here resumes the
thread of his narration, in the very words wherewith he broke it off,
chap. viii, 6. As far as Phenicia to the north, Cyprus to the west, and
Antioch to the east.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p7">20. Some of them were men of Cyprus and Cyrene - Who were
more accustomed to converse with the Gentiles. Who coming into Antioch -
Then the capital of Syria, and, next to Rome and Alexandria, the most
considerable city of the empire. Spake to the Greeks - As the Greeks
were the most celebrated of the Gentile nations near Judea, the Jews
called all the Gentiles by that name. Here we have the first account of
the preaching the Gospel to the idolatrous Gentiles. All those to whom
it had been preached before, did at least worship one God, the God of
Israel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p8">21. And the hand of the Lord - That is, the power of his
Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p9">26. And the disciples were first called Christians at
Antioch - Here it was that they first received this standing
appellation. They were before termed Nazarenes and Galileans.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p10">28. Agabus rising up - In the congregation. All the world -
The word frequently signifies all the Roman empire. And so it is
doubtless to be taken here.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p11">29. Then - Understanding the distress they would otherwise
be in on that account, the disciples determined to send relief to the
brethren in Judea - Who herein received a manifest proof of the reality
of their conversion.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xii-p12">30. Sending it to the elders - Who gave it to the deacons,
to be distributed by them, as every one had need.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="10.70%" prev="i.vi.xii" next="i.vi.xiv" id="i.vi.xiii">
<h3 id="i.vi.xiii-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XII" id="i.vi.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.12" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p1">1. About that time - So wisely did God mix rest and
persecution in due time and measure succeeding each other. Herod -
Agrippa; the latter was his Roman, the former his Syrian name. He was
the grandson of Herod the Great, nephew to Herod Antipas, who beheaded
John the Baptist; brother to Herodias, and father to that Agrippa before
whom St. Paul afterward made his defense. Caligula made him king of the
tetrarchy of his uncle Philip, to which he afterward added the
territories of Antipas. Claudius made him also king of Judea, and added
thereto the dominions of Lysanias.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p2">2. James the brother of John - So one of the brothers went
to God the first, the other the last of the apostles.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p3">3. Then were the days of unleavened bread - At which the
Jews came together from all parts.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p4">4. Four quaternions - Sixteen men, who watched by turns day
and night.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p5">5. Continual prayer was made for him - Yet when their
prayer was answered, they could scarce believe it, ver. 15. But why had
they not prayed for St. James also? Because he was put to death as soon
as apprehended.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p6">6. Peter was sleeping - Easy and void of fear; between two
soldiers - Sufficiently secured to human appearance.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p7">7. His chains - With which his right arm was bound to one
of the soldiers, and his left arm to the other.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p8">8. Gird thyself - Probably he had put off his girdle,
sandals, and upper garment, before he lay down to sleep.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p9">10. The first and second ward - At each of which doubtless
was a guard of soldiers. The gate opened of its own accord - Without
either Peter or the angel touching it. And they went on through one
street - That Peter might know which way to go. And the angel departed
from him - Being himself sufficient for what remained to be done.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p10">11. Now I know of a truth - That this is not a vision, ver.
9.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p11">12. And having considered - What was best to be done. Many
were gathered together - At midnight.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p12">13. The gate - At some distance from the house; to hearken
- If any knocked.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p13">14. And knowing Peter's voice - Bidding her open the
door.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p14">15. They said, Thou art mad - As we say, Sure you are not
in your senses to talk so. It is his angel - It was a common opinion
among the Jews, that every man had his particular guardian angel, who
frequently assumed both his shape and voice. But this is a point on
which the Scriptures are silent.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p15">17. Beckoning to them - Many of whom being amazed, were
talking together. And he said, Show these things to James - The brother
or kinsman of our Lord, and author of the epistle which bears his name.
He appears to have been a person of considerable weight and importance,
probably the chief overseer of that province, and of the Church in
Jerusalem in particular. He went into another place - Where he might be
better concealed till the storm was over.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p16">19. Herod commanded them to be put to death - And thus the
wicked suffered in the room of the righteous. And going down from Judea
- With shame, for not having brought forth Peter, according to his
promise.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p17">20. Having gained Blastus - To their side, they sued for,
and obtained peace - Reconciliation with Herod. And so the Christians of
those parts were, by the providence of God, delivered from scarcity.
Their country was nourished - Was provided with, corn, by the king's
country - Thus Hiram also, king of Tyre, desired of Solomon food or corn
for his household, <scripRef passage="1 Kings v. 9" id="i.vi.xiii-p17.1" parsed="|1Kgs|5|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.5.9">1 Kings v,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p18">21. And on a set day - Which was solemnized yearly, in
honour of Claudius Caesar; Herod, arrayed in royal apparel - In a garment
so wrought with silver, that the rays of the rising sun striking upon,
and being reflected from it, dazzled the eyes of the beholders. The
people shouted, It is the voice of a God - Such profane flattery they
frequently paid to princes. But the commonness of a wicked custom rather
increases than lessens the guilt of it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p19">23. And immediately - God does not delay to vindicate his
injured honour; an angel of the Lord smote him - Of this other
historians say nothing: so wide a difference there is between Divine and
human history! An angel of the Lord brought out Peter; an angel smote
Herod. Men did not see the instruments in either case. These were only
known to the people of God. Because he gave not glory to God - He
willingly received it to himself, and by this sacrilege filled up the
measure of his iniquities. So then vengeance tarried not. And he was
eaten by worms, or vermin - How changed! And on the fifth day expired in
exquisite torture. Such was the event! The persecutor perished, and the
Gospel grew and multiplied.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiii-p20">25. Saul returned - To Antioch; taking John, surnamed Mark
- The son of Mary, (at whose house the disciples met, to pray for
Peter,) who was sister to Barnabas.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="10.78%" prev="i.vi.xiii" next="i.vi.xv" id="i.vi.xiv">
<h3 id="i.vi.xiv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XIII" id="i.vi.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.13" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p1">1. Manaen, who had been brought up with Herod - His foster
brother, now freed from the temptations of a court.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p2">2. Separate me Barnabas and Saul for the work to which I
have called them - This was not ordaining them. St. Paul was ordained
long before, and that not of men, neither by man: it was only inducting
him to the province for which our Lord had appointed him from the
beginning, and which was now revealed to the prophets and teachers. In
consequence of this they fasted, prayed, and laid their hands on them, a
rite which was used not in ordination only, but in blessing, and on many
other occasions.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p3">3. Then having fasted - Again. Thus they did also, chap.
xiv, 23.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p4">5. In the synagogues - Using all opportunities that
offered.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p5">6. Paphos was on the western, Salamis on the eastern part
of the island.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p6">7. The proconsul - The Roman governor of Cyprus, a prudent
man - And therefore not overswayed by Elymas, but desirous to inquire
farther.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p7">9. Then Saul, who was also called Paul - It is not
improbable, that coming now among the Romans, they would naturally adapt
his name to their own language, and so called him Paul instead of Saul.
Perhaps the family of the proconsul might be the first who addressed to
or spoke of him by this name. And from this time, being the apostle of
the Gentiles, he himself used the name which was more familiar to
them.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p8">10. O full of all guile - As a false prophet, and all
mischief - As a magician. Thou son of the devil - A title well suited to
a magician; and one who not only was himself unrighteous, but laboured
to keep others from all goodness. Wilt thou not cease to pervert the
right ways of the Lord? - Even now thou hast heard the truth of the
Gospel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p9">11. And immediately a mist - Or dimness within, and
darkness without, fell upon him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p10">12. Being astonished at the doctrine of the Lord -
Confirmed by such a miracle.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p11">13. John withdrawing from them returned - Tired with the
fatigue, or shrinking from danger.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p12">14. Antioch in Pisidia - Different from the Antioch
mentioned ver. 1.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p13">15. And after the reading of the law and the prophets, the
chief of the synagogue sent to them - The law was read over once every
year, a portion of it every Sabbath: to which was added a lesson taken
out of the prophets. After this was over, any one might speak to the
people, on any subject he thought convenient. Yet it was a circumstance
of decency which Paul and Barnabas would hardly omit, to acquaint the
rulers with their desire of doing it: probably by some message before
the service began.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p14">16. Ye that fear God - Whether proselytes or heathens.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p15">17. The God - By such a commemoration of God's favours to
their fathers, at once their minds were conciliated to the speaker, they
were convinced of their duty to God, and invited to believe his promise,
and the accomplishment of it. The six verses 17-22, contain the whole
sum of the Old Testament. Of this people - Paul here chiefly addresses
himself to those whom he styles, Ye that fear God: he speaks of Israel
first; and ver. 26, speaks more directly to the Israelites themselves.
Chose - And this exalted the people; not any merit or goodness of their
own, <scripRef passage="Ezek. xx. 5" id="i.vi.xiv-p15.1" parsed="|Ezek|20|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.20.5">Ezek. xx, 5</scripRef>. Our fathers - Abraham and his posterity. <scripRef passage="Isaiah i. 2" id="i.vi.xiv-p15.2" parsed="|Isa|1|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.1.2">Isaiah i,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p16">18. <scripRef passage="Deut. i. 31" id="i.vi.xiv-p16.1" parsed="|Deut|1|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.1.31">Deut. i,
31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p17">19. Seven nations - Enumerated <scripRef passage="Deut. vii. 1" id="i.vi.xiv-p17.1" parsed="|Deut|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.7.1">Deut. vii, 1</scripRef>; about four hundred and fifty years - That is, from the
choice of the fathers to the dividing of the land; it was about four
hundred and fifty years.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p18">21. He gave them Saul forty years - Including the time
wherein Samuel judged Israel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p19">22. Having removed him - Hence they might understand that
the dispensations of God admit of various changes. I have found David, a
man after my own heart - This expression is to be taken in a limited
sense. David was such at that time, but not at all times. And he was so,
in that respect, as he performed all God's will, in the particulars
there mentioned: But he was not a man after God's own heart, in other
respects, wherein he performed his own will. In the matter of Uriah, for
instance, he was as far from being a man after God's own heart as Saul
himself was. It is therefore a very gross, as well as dangerous mistake,
to suppose this is the character of David in every part of his
behaviour. We must beware of this, unless we would recommend adultery
and murder as things after God's own heart.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p20"><scripRef passage="1 Sam. xvi. 12, 13" id="i.vi.xiv-p20.1" parsed="|1Sam|16|12|16|13" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.16.12-1Sam.16.13">1 Sam. xvi, 12,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p21">24. John having first preached - He mentions this, as a
thing already known to them. And so doubtless it was. For it gave so
loud an alarm to the whole Jewish nation, as could not but be heard of
in foreign countries, at least as remote as Pisidia.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p22">25. His course - His work was quickly finished, and might
therefore well be termed a course or race. <scripRef passage="Luke iii. 16" id="i.vi.xiv-p22.1" parsed="|Luke|3|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3.16">Luke iii, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p23">27. For they that dwell at Jerusalem, and their rulers - He
here anticipates a strong objection, "Why did not they at Jerusalem, and
especially their rulers, believe?" They know not him, because they
understood not those very prophets whom they read or heard continually.
Their very condemning him, innocent as he was, proves that they
understood not the prophecies concerning him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p24">29. They fulfilled all things that were written of him - So
far could they go, but no farther.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p25">31. He was seen many days by them who came up with him from
Galilee to Jerusalem - This last journey both presupposes all the rest,
and was the most important of all.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p26">33. Thou art my Son, this day have I begotten thee - It is
true, he was the Son of God from eternity. The meaning therefore is, I
have this day declared thee to be my Son. As St. Paul elsewhere,
declared to be the Son of God with power, by the resurrection from the
dead, <scripRef passage="Rom. i. 4" id="i.vi.xiv-p26.1" parsed="|Rom|1|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.1.4">Rom. i, 4</scripRef>. And it is with peculiar propriety and beauty that God is
said to have begotten him, on the day when he raised him from the dead,
as he seemed then to be born out of the earth anew. <scripRef passage="Psalm ii. 7" id="i.vi.xiv-p26.2" parsed="|Ps|2|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.2.7">Psalm ii,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p27">34. No more to return to corruption - That is, to die no
more. I will give you the sure mercies of David - The blessings promised
to David in Christ. These are sure, certain, firm, solid, to every true
believer in him. And hence the resurrection of Christ necessarily
follows; for without this, those blessings could not be given. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lv. 3" id="i.vi.xiv-p27.1" parsed="|Isa|55|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.55.3">Isaiah lv, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p28">35. He saith - David in the name of the Messiah. <scripRef passage="Psalm xvi. 10" id="i.vi.xiv-p28.1" parsed="|Ps|16|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.16.10">Psalm xvi, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p29">36. David, having served the will of God in his generation,
fell asleep - So his service extended not itself beyond the bounds of
the common age of man: but the service of the Messiah to all
generations, as his kingdom to all ages. Served the will of God - Why
art thou here thou who art yet in the world? Is it not that thou also
mayest serve the will of God? Art thou serving it now? Doing all his
will? And was added to his fathers - Not only in body. This expression
refers to the soul also, and supposes the immortality of it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p30">39. Everyone that believeth is justified from all things -
Has the actual forgiveness of all his sins, at the very time of his
believing; from which ye could not be justified - Not only ye cannot
now; but ye never could. For it afforded no expiation for presumptuous
sins. By the law of Moses - The whole Mosaic institution! The division
of the law into moral and ceremonial was not so common among the Jews,
as it is among us. Nor does the apostle here consider it at all: but
Moses and Christ are opposed to each other.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p31">40. Beware - A weighty and seasonable admonition. No
reproof is as yet added to it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p32">41. I work a work which ye will in nowise believe - This
was originally spoken to those, who would not believe that God would
ever deliver them from the power of the Chaldeans. But it is applicable
to any who will not believe the promises, or the works of God. <scripRef passage="Hab. i. 5" id="i.vi.xiv-p32.1" parsed="|Hab|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hab.1.5">Hab. i, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p33">42. When the Jews were going out - Probably many of them,
not bearing to hear him, went out before he had done. The Sabbath
between - So the Jews call to this day the Sabbath between the first day
of the month Tisri (on which the civil year begins) and the tenth of the
same month, which is the solemn day of expiation.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p34">43. Who speaking to them - More familiarly, persuaded them
to continue - For trials were at hand, in the grace of God - That is, to
adhere to the Gospel or Christian faith.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p35">46. Then Paul and Barnabas speaking boldly, said - Those
who hinder others must be publicly reproved. It was necessary - Though
ye are not worthy: he shows that he had not preached to them, from any
confidence of their believing, but seeing ye judge yourselves unworthy
of eternal life - They indeed judged none but themselves worthy of it.
Yet their rejecting of the Gospel was the same as saying, "We are
unworthy of eternal life." Behold! - A thing now present! An astonishing
revolution! We turn to the Gentiles - Not that they left off preaching
to the Jews in other places. But they now determined to lose no more
time at Antioch on their ungrateful countrymen, but to employ themselves
wholly in doing what they could for the conversion of the Gentiles
there.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p36">47. For so hath the Lord commanded us - By sending us
forth, and giving us an opportunity of fulfilling what he had foretold.
I have set thee - The Father speaks to Christ. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xlix. 6" id="i.vi.xiv-p36.1" parsed="|Isa|49|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.49.6">Isaiah xlix, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xiv-p37">48. As many as were ordained to eternal life - St. Luke
does not say fore-ordained. He is not speaking of what was done from
eternity, but of what was then done, through the preaching of the
Gospel. He is describing that ordination, and that only, which was at
the very time of hearing it. During this sermon those believed, says the
apostle, to whom God then gave power to believe. It is as if he had
said, "They believed, whose hearts the Lord opened;" as he expresses it
in a clearly parallel place, speaking of the same kind of ordination,
chap. xvi, 14, &amp;c. It is observable, the original word is not once
used in Scripture to express eternal predestination of any kind. The sum
is, all those and those only, who were now ordained, now believed. Not
that God rejected the rest: it was his will that they also should have
been saved: but they thrust salvation from them. Nor were they who then
believed constrained to believe. But grace was then first copiously
offered them. And they did not thrust it away, so that a great multitude
even of Gentiles were converted. In a word, the expression properly
implies, a present operation of Divine grace working faith in the
hearers.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="10.96%" prev="i.vi.xiv" next="i.vi.xvi" id="i.vi.xv">
<h3 id="i.vi.xv-p0.1">XIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XIV" id="i.vi.xv-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.14" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xv-p1">1. They so spake - Persecution having increased their
strength.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p2">9. He had faith to be healed - He felt the power of God in
his soul; and thence knew it was sufficient to heal his body also.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p3">11. The gods are come down - Which the heathens supposed
they frequently did; Jupiter especially. But how amazingly does the
prince of darkness blind the minds of them that believe not! The Jews
would not own Christ's Godhead, though they saw him work numberless
miracles. On the other hand, the heathens seeing mere men work one
miracle, were for deifying them immediately.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p4">13. The priest of Jupiter - Whose temple and image were
just without the gate of the city, brought garlands - To put on the
victims, and bulls - The usual offerings to Jupiter.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p5">14. They sprang in among the people, crying out - As in a
fire, or other sudden and great danger.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p6">15. To turn from these vanities - From worshipping any but
the true God. He does not deign to call them gods; unto the living God -
Not like these dead idols; who made the heaven and the earth, the sea -
Each of which they supposed to have its own gods.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p7">16. Who in times past - He prevents their objection, "But
if these things are so, we should have heard them from our fathers."
Suffered - An awful judgment, all nations - The multitude of them that
err does not turn error into truth, to walk in their own ways - The
idolatries which they had chosen.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p8">17. He left not himself without witness - For the heathens
had always from God himself a testimony both of his existence and of his
providence; in that he did good - Even by punishments he testifies of
himself; but more peculiarly by benefits; giving rain - By which air,
earth, and sea, are, as it were, all joined together; from heaven - The
seat of God; to which St. Paul probably pointed while he spoke, filling
the body with food, the soul with gladness.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p9">19. Who persuaded the multitude - Moved with equal ease
either to adore or murder him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p10">20. But as the disciples stood round - Probably after
sunset. The enraged multitude would scarce have suffered it in the day
time: he rose and went into the city - That he should be able to do
this, just after he had been left for dead, was a miracle little less
than a resurrection from the dead. Especially considering the manner
wherein the Jewish malefactors were stoned. The witnesses first threw as
large a stone as they could lift, with all possible violence upon his
head, which alone was sufficient to dash the skull in pieces. All the
people then joined, as long as any motion or token of life remained.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p11">23. When they had ordained them presbyters in every Church
- Out of those who were themselves but newly converted. So soon can God
enable even a babe in Christ to build up others in the common faith:
they commended them to the Lord - An expression implying faith in
Christ, as well as love to the brethren.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p12">25. Perga and Attalia were cities of Pamphylia.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xv-p13">26. Recommended to the grace - Or favour, of God, for the
work which they had fulfilled - This shows the nature and design of that
laying on of hands, which was mentioned chap. xiii, 3.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="11.02%" prev="i.vi.xv" next="i.vi.xvii" id="i.vi.xvi">
<h3 id="i.vi.xvi-p0.1">XV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XV" id="i.vi.xvi-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.15" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p1">1. Coming down from Judea - Perhaps to supply what they
thought Paul and Barnabas had omitted.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p2">2. They (the brethren) determined that Paul and Barnabas,
and certain others should go up to Jerusalem about this question - This
is the journey to which St. Paul refers, <scripRef passage="Gal. ii. 1, 2" id="i.vi.xvi-p2.1" parsed="|Gal|2|1|2|2" osisRef="Bible:Gal.2.1-Gal.2.2">Gal. ii, 1, 2</scripRef>, when he says he went up by Revelation: which is very
consistent with this; for the Church in sending them might be directed
by a Revelation made either immediately to St. Paul, or to some other
person, relating to so important an affair. Important indeed it was,
that these Jewish impositions should be solemnly opposed in time;
because multitudes of converts were still zealous for the law, and ready
to contend for the observance of it. Indeed many of the Christians of
Antioch would have acquiesced in the determination of Paul alone. But as
many others might have prejudices against him, for his having been so
much concerned for the Gentiles, it was highly expedient to take the
concurrent judgment of all the apostles on this occasion.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p3">4. They were received - That is solemnly welcomed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p4">5. But certain Pharisees - For even believers are apt to
retain their former turn of mind, and prejudices derived therefrom. The
law of Moses - The whole law, both moral and ritual.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p5">7. After much debate - It does not appear that this was
among the apostles themselves. But if it had, if they themselves had
debated at first, yet might their final decision be from an unerring
direction. For how really soever they were inspired, we need not suppose
their inspiration was always so instantaneous and express, as to
supersede any deliberation in their own minds, or any consultation with
each other. Peter rose up - This is the last time he is mentioned in the
Acts.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p6">8. God bare them witness - That he had accepted them, by
giving them the Holy Ghost.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p7">9. Purifying - This word is repeated from chap. x, 15;
their hearts - The heart is the proper seat of purity; by faith -
Without concerning themselves with the Mosaic law.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p8">10. Now therefore - Seeing these things are so: why tempt
ye God? - Why do ye provoke him to anger, by putting so heavy a yoke on
their neck?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p9">11. The Lord Jesus - He does not here say our Lord; because
in this solemn place he means the Lord of all, we - Jews, shall be saved
even as they - Gentiles, namely, through the grace of the Lord Jesus,
not by our observance of the ceremonial law.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p10">12. Miracles and wonders - By which also what St. Peter had
said was confirmed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p11">14. Simon hath declared - James, the apostle of the
Hebrews, calls Peter by his Hebrew name. To take out of them a people
for his name - That is to believe in him, to be called by his name.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p12">15. To this agree - St. Peter had urged the plain fact,
which St. James confirms by Scripture prophecy. The words of the
prophets - One of whom is immediately cited.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p13">16. After this - After the Jewish dispensation expires. I
will build again the fallen tabernacle of David - By raising from his
seed the Christ, who shall build on the ruins of his fallen tabernacle a
spiritual and eternal kingdom. <scripRef passage="Amos ix. 11" id="i.vi.xvi-p13.1" parsed="|Amos|9|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Amos.9.11">Amos ix,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p14">17. The Gentiles on whom my name is called - That is, who
are called by my name; who are my people.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p15">18. Known unto God are all his works from eternity - Which
the apostle infers from the prophecy itself, and the accomplishment of
it. And this conversion of the Gentiles being known to him from
eternity, we ought not to think a new or strange thing. It is
observable, he does not speak of God's works in the natural world,
(which had been nothing to his present purpose,) but of his dealing with
the children of men. Now he could not know these, without knowing the
characters and actions of particular persons, on a correspondence with
which the wisdom and goodness of his providential dispensations is
founded. For instance, he could not know how he would deal with heathen
idolaters (whom he was now calling into his Church) without knowing
there would be heathen idolaters: and yet this was a thing purely
contingent, a thing as dependent on the freedom of the human mind, as
any we can imagine. This text, therefore, among a thousand more, is an
unanswerable proof, that God foreknows future contingencies, though
there are difficulties relating hereto which men cannot solve.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p16">20. To abstain from fornication - Which even the
philosophers among the heathens did not account any fault. It was
particularly frequent in the worship of their idols, on which account
they are here named together. And from things strangled - That is, from
whatever had been killed, without pouring out the blood. When God first
permitted man to eat flesh, he commanded Noah, and in him all his
posterity, whenever they killed any creature for food, to abstain from
the blood thereof. It was to be poured upon the ground as water:
doubtless in honour of that blood which was in due time poured out for
the sin of the world.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p17">21. Perhaps the connection is, To the Jews we need write
nothing on these heads; for they hear the law continually.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p18">22. With the whole Church - Which therefore had a part
therein; to send chosen men - Who might put it beyond all dispute, that
this was the judgment of the apostles and all the brethren.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p19">23. Writing thus, and sending it by their hand - The whole
conduct of this affair plainly shows that the Church in those days had
no conception of St. Peter's primacy, or of his being the chief judge in
controversies. For the decree is drawn up, not according to his, but the
Apostle James's proposal and direction: and that in the name, not of St.
Peter, but of all the apostles and elders, and of the whole Church. Nay,
St. Peter's name is not mentioned at all, either in the order for
sending to Jerusalem on the question, ver. 2, or in the address of the
messengers concerning it, ver. 4, or in the letter which was written in
answer.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p20">24. Forasmuch as, &amp;c. - The simplicity, weightiness,
and conciseness of this letter are highly observable.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p21">26. Men that have hazarded their lives - This is spoken of
Paul and Barnabas.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p22">27. Who will tell you the same things - Which we have
written.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p23">28. These necessary things - All of these were necessary
for that time. But the first of them was not necessary long; and the
direction concerning it was therefore repealed by the same Spirit, as we
read in the former Epistle to the Corinthians.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p24">29. Blood - The eating which was never permitted the
children of God from the beginning of the world. Nothing can be clearer
than this. For,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.xvi-p25">1. From Adam to Noah no man ate flesh at all;
consequently no man then ate blood.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.xvi-p26">2. When God allowed Noah and his posterity to
eat flesh, he absolutely forbade them to eat blood; and accordingly
this, with the other six precepts of Noah, was delivered down from Noah
to Moses.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.xvi-p27">3. God renewed this prohibition by Moses,
which was not repealed from the time of Moses till Christ came.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.xvi-p28">4. Neither after his coming did any presume
to repeal this decree of the Holy Ghost, till it seemed good to the
bishop of Rome so to do, about the middle of the eighth century.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.xvi-p29">5. From that time those Churches which
acknowledged his authority held the eating of blood to be an indifferent
thing. But,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.xvi-p30">6. In all those Churches which never did
acknowledge the bishop of Rome's authority, it never was allowed to eat
blood; nor is it allowed at this day. This is the plain fact; let men
reason as plausibly as they please on one side or the other. From which
keeping yourselves ye will do well - That is, ye will find a blessing.
This gentle manner of concluding was worthy the apostolical wisdom and
goodness. But how soon did succeeding councils of inferior authority
change it into the style of anathemas! Forms which have proved an
occasion of consecrating some of the most devilish passions under the
most sacred names; and like some ill-adjusted weapons of war, are most
likely to hurt the hand from which they are thrown.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p31">35. Paul and Barnabas abode in Antioch - And it was during
this time that Peter came down from Jerusalem, and that St. Paul
withstood him to the face, for separating himself from the Gentiles, <scripRef passage="Gal. ii. 11" id="i.vi.xvi-p31.1" parsed="|Gal|2|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.2.11">Gal. ii, 11</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p32">36. Let us go and visit the brethren in every city where we
have preached - This was all that St. Paul designed at first; but it was
not all that God designed by his journey, whose providence carried him
much farther than he intended. And see how they do - How their souls
prosper: how they grow in faith, hope love: what else ought to be the
grand and constant inquiry in every ecclesiastical visitation? Reader,
how dost thou do?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p33">37. Barnabas counselled to take John - His kinsman.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p34">38. But Paul thought it not right - To trust him again, who
had deserted them before: who had shrunk from the labour and danger of
converting those they were now going to confirm.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p35">39. And there was a sharp contention - Literally, a
paroxysm, or fit of a fever. But nothing in the text implies that the
sharpness was on both sides. It is far more probable that it was not;
that St. Paul, who had the right on his side, as he undoubtedly had,)
maintained it with love. And Barnabas taking Mark with him, sailed away
to Cyprus - Forsaking the work in which he was engaged, he went away to
his own country.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvi-p36">40. But Paul departed - Held on his intended course: being
recommended by the brethren to the grace of God - We do not find that
Barnabas stayed for this. O how mighty is the grace of God! which in the
midst of the world, in the midst of sin, among so many snares of Satan,
and in spite of the incredible weakness and depravity of nature, yet
overcomes all opposition, sanctifies, sustains, and preserves us to the
end! It appears not only that Paul and Barnabas were afterward
thoroughly reconciled, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. ix. 6" id="i.vi.xvi-p36.1" parsed="|1Cor|9|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.9.6">1 Cor. ix,
6</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Gal. ii. 9" id="i.vi.xvi-p36.2" parsed="|Gal|2|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.2.9">Gal. ii, 9</scripRef>; but also that John was again admitted by St. Paul as a
companion in his labours, <scripRef passage="Colossians iv. 10" id="i.vi.xvi-p36.3" parsed="|Col|4|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.4.10">Colossians iv,
10</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Phil. i. 24" id="i.vi.xvi-p36.4" parsed="|Phil|1|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.1.24">Phil. i, 24</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="2 Tim. iv. 11" id="i.vi.xvi-p36.5" parsed="|2Tim|4|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.4.11">2 Tim. iv, 11</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="11.19%" prev="i.vi.xvi" next="i.vi.xviii" id="i.vi.xvii">
<h3 id="i.vi.xvii-p0.1">XVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XVI" id="i.vi.xvii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.16" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p1">3. He took and circumcised him because of the Jews - The
unbelieving Jews, to whom he designed he should preach. For they would
not have conversed with him at all, so long as he was uncircumcised.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p2">6. And having gone through Phrygia - And spoken there what
was sufficient, as well as in the region of Galatia, being forbid by the
Spirit (probably by an inward dictate) to speak as yet in the
proconsular Asia, the time for it not being come.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p3">7. Coming to Mysia, and passing it by, as being a part of
Asia, they attempted to go into Bithynia; but the Spirit suffered them
not - Forbidding them as before. Sometimes a strong impression, for
which we are not able to give any account, is not altogether to be
despised.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p4">9. A vision appeared to Paul by night - It was not a dream,
though it was by night. No other dream is mentioned in the New Testament
than that of Joseph and of Pilate's wife. A man of Macedonia - Probably
an angel clothed in the Macedonian habit, or using the language of the
country, and representing the inhabitants of it. Help us - Against
Satan, ignorance, and sin.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p5">10. We sought to go into Macedonia - This is the first
place in which St. Luke intimates his attendance on the apostle. And
here he does it only in an oblique manner. Nor does he throughout the
history once mention his own name, or any one thing which he did or said
for the service of Christianity; though Paul speaks of him in the most
honourable terms, <scripRef passage="Colossians iv. 14" id="i.vi.xvii-p5.1" parsed="|Col|4|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.4.14">Colossians iv,
14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="2 Tim. iv. 11" id="i.vi.xvii-p5.2" parsed="|2Tim|4|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.4.11">2 Tim. iv, 11</scripRef>; and probably as the brother whose praise in the Gospel went
through all the Churches, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. viii. 18" id="i.vi.xvii-p5.3" parsed="|2Cor|8|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.8.18">2 Cor. viii, 18</scripRef>. The same remark may be made on the rest of the sacred
historians, who every one of them show the like amiable modesty.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p6">11. We ran with a straight course - Which increased their
confidence that God had called them.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p7">12. The first city - Neapolis was the first city they came
to in that part of Macedonia which was nearest to Asia: in that part
which was farthest from it, Philippi. The river Strymon ran between
them. Philippi was a Roman colony.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p8">13. We went out of the gate - The Jews usually held their
religious assemblies (either by choice or constraint) at a distance from
the heathens: by a river side - Which was also convenient for purifying
themselves. Where prayer was wont to be made - Though it does not appear
there was any house built there. We spake - At first in a familiar
manner. Paul did not immediately begin to preach.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p9">14. A worshipper of God - Probably acquainted with the
prophetic writings whose heart the Lord opened - The Greek word properly
refers to the opening of the eyes: and the heart has its eyes, <scripRef passage="Eph. i. 18" id="i.vi.xvii-p9.1" parsed="|Eph|1|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.1.18">Eph. i, 18</scripRef>. These are closed by nature and to open them is the peculiar
work of God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p10">15. She was baptized and her family - Who can believe that
in so many families there was no infant? Or that the Jews, who were so
long accustomed to circumcise their children, would not now devote them
to God by baptism? She entreated us - The souls of the faithful cleave
to those by whom they were gained to God. She constrained us - By her
importunity. They did not immediately comply, lest any should imagine
they sought their own profit by coming into Macedonia.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p11">17. These men are - A great truth: but St. Paul did not
need, nor would accept, of such testimony.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p12">19. The magistrates - The supreme magistrates of the city.
In the next verse they are called by a title which often signifies
pretors. These officers exercised both the military and civil
authority.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p13">20. Being Jews - A nation peculiarly despised by the
Romans.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p14">21. And teach customs which it is not lawful for us to
receive - The world has received all the rules and doctrines of all the
philosophers that ever were. But this is a property of Gospel truth: it
has something in it peculiarly intolerable to the world.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p15">23. They laid many stripes upon them - Either they did not
immediately say they were Romans, or in the tumult it was not regarded.
Charging the jailer - Perhaps rather to quiet the people than because
they thought them criminal.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p16">24. Secured their feet in the stocks - These were probably
those large pieces of wood, in use among the Romans, which not only
loaded the legs of the prisoner, but also kept them extended in a very
painful manner.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p17">25. Paul and Silas sung a hymn to God - Notwithstanding
weariness, hunger stripes, and blood. And the prisoners heard - A song
to which they were not accustomed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p18">28. But Paul cried - As they were all then in the dark, it
is not easy to say, how Paul knew of the jailer's purpose; unless it
were by some immediate notice from God, which is by no means incredible.
With a loud voice - Through earnestness, and because he was at some
distance. Do thyself no harm - Although the Christian faith opens the
prospect into another life, yet it absolutely forbids and effectually
prevents a man's discharging himself from this.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p19">30. Sirs - He did not style them so the day before. What
must I do to be saved? - From the guilt I feel and the vengeance I fear?
Undoubtedly God then set his sins in array before him, and convinced him
in the clearest and strongest manner that the wrath of God abode upon
him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p20">31. Thou shalt be saved and thy household - If ye believe.
They did so, and were saved.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p21">33. He washed their stripes - It should not be forgot, that
the apostles had not the power of working miraculous cures when they
pleased, either on themselves, or their dearest friends. Nor was it
expedient they should, since it would have frustrated many wise designs
of God, which were answered by their sufferings.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p22">34. He set a table before them and rejoiced - Faith makes a
man joyful, prudent, liberal.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p23">35. The pretors sent - Being probably terrified by the
earthquake; saying, Let those men go - How different from the charge
given a few hours before! And how great an ease of mind to the
jailer!</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p24">37. They have beaten us publicly, being Roman - St. Paul
does not always plead this privilege. But in a country where they were
entire strangers, such treatment might have brought upon them a
suspicion of having been guilty of some uncommon crime, and so have
hindered the course of the Gospel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xvii-p25">40. When they had seen the brethren, they comforted them
and departed - Though many circumstances now invited their stay, yet
they wisely complied with the request of the magistrates, that they
might not seem to express any degree of obstinacy or revenge, or give
any suspicion of a design to stir up the people.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="11.30%" prev="i.vi.xvii" next="i.vi.xix" id="i.vi.xviii">
<h3 id="i.vi.xviii-p0.1">XVII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XVII" id="i.vi.xviii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.17" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p1">1. And taking their journey through Amphipolis and
Apollonia - St. Luke seems to have been left at Philippi; and to have
continued in those parts, travelling from place to place among the
Churches, till St. Paul returned thither. For here he leaves off
speaking of himself as one of St. Paul's company; neither does he resume
that style, till we find them together there, chap. xx, 5, 6. After this
he constantly uses it to the end of the history. Amphipolis and
Apollonia were cities of Macedonia.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p2">2. And Paul, according to his custom - Of doing all things,
as far as might be, in a regular manner, went in to them three Sabbath
days - Not excluding the days between.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p3">4. Of the principal women, not a few - Our free thinkers
pique themselves upon observing, that women are more religious than men;
and this, in compliment both to religion and good manners, they impute
to the weakness of their understandings. And indeed as far as nature can
go, in imitating religion by performing the outward acts of it, this
picture of religion may make a fairer show in women than in men, both by
reason of their more tender passions, and their modesty, which will make
those actions appear to more advantage. But in the case of true
religion, which always implies taking up the cross, especially in time
of persecution, women lie naturally under a great disadvantage, as
having less courage than men. So that their embracing the Gospel was a
stronger evidence of the power of him whose strength is perfected in
weakness, as a stronger assistance of the Holy Spirit was needful for
them to overcome their natural fearfulness.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p4">11. These were more ingenuous - Or generous. To be
teachable in the things of God is true generosity of soul. The receiving
the word with all readiness of mind, and the most accurate search into
the truth, are well consistent.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p5">12. Many of the - Of the Jews. And of the Grecian women -
Who were followed by their husbands.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p6">16. While Paul was waiting for the - Having no design, as
it seems, to preach at Athens, but his zeal for God drew him into it
unawares, without staying till his companions came.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p7">18. Some of the Epicurean and Stoic philosopher - The
Epicureans entirely denied a providence, and held the world to be the
effect of mere chance; asserting sensual pleasure to be man's chief
good, and that the soul and body died together. The Stoics held, that
matter was eternal; that all things were governed by irresistible fate;
that virtue was its own sufficient reward, and vice its own sufficient
punishment. It is easy to see, how happily the apostle levels his
discourse at some of the most important errors of each, while, without
expressly attacking either, he gives a plain summary of his own
religious principles. What would this babbler say? - Such is the
language of natural reason, full of, and satisfied with itself. Yet even
here St. Paul had some fruit; though nowhere less than at Athens. And no
wonder, since this city was a seminary of philosophers, who have ever
been the pest of true religion. He seemeth to be a proclaimer - This he
returns upon them at the 23rd verse; of strange gods - Such as are not
known even at Athens. Because he preached to them Jesus and the
resurrection - A God and a goddess. And as stupid as this mistake was,
it is the less to be wondered at, since the Athenians might as well
count the resurrection a deity, as shame, famine, and many others.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p8">19. The Areopagus, or hill of Mars, (dedicated to Mars, the
heathen God of war,) was the place where the Athenians held their
supreme court of judicature. But it does not appear he was carried
thither as a criminal. The original number of its Judges was twelve; but
afterward it increased to three hundred. These were generally men of the
greatest families in Athens, and were famed for justice and
integrity.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p9">21. And the strangers sojourning there - And catching the
distemper of them. Some new thing - The Greek word signifies some newer
thing. New things quickly grew cheap, and they wanted those that were
newer still.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p10">22. Then Paul standing in the midst of the Areopagus - An
ample theatre; said - Giving them a lecture of natural divinity, with
admirable wisdom, acuteness, fulness, and courtesy. They inquire after
new things: Paul in his divinely philosophical discourse, begins with
the first, and goes on to the last things, both which were new things to
them. He points out the origin and the end of all things, concerning
which they had so many disputes, and equally refutes both the Epicurean
and Stoic. I perceive - With what clearness and freedom does he speak!
Paul against Athens!</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p11">23. I found an altar - Some suppose this was set up by
Socrates, to express in a covert way his devotion to the only true God,
while he derided the plurality of the heathen gods, for which he was
condemned to death: and others, that whoever erected this altar, did it
in honour to the God of Israel, of whom there was no image, and whose
name Jehovah was never made known to the idolatrous Gentiles. Him
proclaim I unto you - Thus he fixes the wandering attention of these
blind philosophers; proclaiming to them an unknown, and yet not a new
God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p12">24. God who made the world - Thus is demonstrated even to
reason, the one true, good God; absolutely different from the creatures,
from every part of the visible creation.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p13">25. Neither is he served as though he needed any thing - or
person - The Greek word equally takes in both. To all - That live and
breathe;-in him we live; and breathe - In him we move. By breathing life
is continued. I breathe this moment: the next is not in my power: and
all things - For in him we are. So exactly do the parts of this
discourse answer each other.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p14">26. He hath made of one blood the whole nation of men - By
this expression the apostle showed them in the most unaffected manner,
that though he was a Jew, be was not enslaved to any narrow views, but
looked on all mankind as his brethren: having determined the times -
That it is God who gave men the earth to inhabit, Paul proves from the
order of times and places, showing the highest wisdom of the Disposer,
superior to all human counsels. And the bounds of their habitation - By
mountains, seas, rivers, and the like.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p15">27. If haply - The way is open; God is ready to be found.
But he will lay no force upon man; they might feel after him - This is
in the midst between seeking and finding. Feeling being the lowest and
grossest of all our senses, is fitly applied to the low knowledge of
God; though he be not far from every one of us - We need not go far to
seek or find him. He is very near us; in us. It is only perverse reason
which thinks he is afar off.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p16">28. In him - Not in ourselves, we live, and move, and have
our being - This denotes his necessary, intimate, and most efficacious
presence. No words can better express the continual and necessary
dependence of all created beings, in their existence and all their
operations, on the first and almighty cause, which the truest philosophy
as well as divinity teaches. As certain also of your own poets have said
- Aratus, whose words these are, was an Athenian, who lived almost three
hundred years before this time. They are likewise to be found, with the
alteration of one letter only, in the hymn of Cleanthes to Jupiter or
the supreme being, one of the purest and finest pieces of natural
religion in the whole world of Pagan antiquity.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p17">29. We ought not to think - A tender expression especially
in the first per son plural. As if he had said, Can God himself be a
less noble being than we who are his offspring? Nor does he only here
deny, that these are like God, but that they have any analogy to him at
all, so as to be capable of representing him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p18">30. The times of ignorance - What! does he object ignorance
to the knowing Athenians? Yes, and they acknowledge it by this very
altar. God overlooked - As one paraphrases, "The beams of his eye did in
a manner shoot over it." He did not appear to take notice of them, by
sending express messages to them as he did to the Jews. But now - This
day, this hour, saith Paul, puts an end to the Divine forbearance, and
brings either greater mercy or punishment. Now he commandeth all men
everywhere to repent - There is a dignity and grandeur in this
expression, becoming an ambassador from the King of heaven. And this
universal demand of repentance declared universal guilt in the strongest
manner, and admirably confronted the pride of the haughtiest Stoic of
them all. At the same time it bore down the idle plea of fatality. For
how could anyone repent of doing what he could not but have done?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p19">31. He hath appointed a day in which he will judge the
world - How fitly does he speak this, in their supreme court of justice?
By the man - So he speaks, suiting himself to the capacity of his
hearers. Whereof he hath given assurance to all men, in that he hath
raised him from the dead - God raising Jesus demonstrated hereby, that
he was to be the glorious Judge of all. We are by no means to imagine
that this was all which the apostle intended to have said, but the
indolence of some of his hearers and the petulancy of others cut him
short.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p20">32. Some mocked - Interrupting him thereby. They took
offense at that which is the principal motive of faith, from the pride
of reason. And having once stumbled at this, they rejected all the
rest.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p21">33. So Paul departed - Leaving his hearers divided in their
judgment.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xviii-p22">34. Among whom was even Dionysius the Areopagite - One of
the Judges of that court: on whom some spurious writings have been
fathered in later ages, by those who are fond of high sounding
nonsense.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="11.47%" prev="i.vi.xviii" next="i.vi.xx" id="i.vi.xix">
<h3 id="i.vi.xix-p0.1">XVIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XVIII" id="i.vi.xix-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.18" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xix-p1">1. Paul departing from Athens - He did not stay there long.
The philosophers there were too easy, too indolent, and too wise in
their own eyes to receive the Gospel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p2">2. Claudius, the Roman emperor, had commanded all the Jews
to depart from Rome - All who were Jews by birth. Whether they were Jews
or Christians by religion, the Roman were too stately to regard.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p3">3. They were tent makers by trade - For it was a rule among
the Jews (and why is it not among the Christians?) to bring up all their
children to some trade, were they ever so rich or noble.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p4">5. And when Silas and Timotheus were come from Macedonia -
Silas seems to have stayed a considerable time at Berea: but Timotheus
had come to the apostle while he was at Athens, and been sent by him to
comfort and confirm the Church at Thessalonica, <scripRef passage="1 Thess. iii. 1-5" id="i.vi.xix-p4.1" parsed="|1Thess|3|1|3|5" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.3.1-1Thess.3.5">1 Thess. iii, 1-5</scripRef>. But now at length both Silas and Timotheus came to the
apostle at Corinth. Paul was pressed in spirit - The more probably from
what Silas and Timotheus related. Every Christian ought diligently to
observe any such pressure in his own spirit, and if it agree with
Scripture, to follow it: if he does not he will feel great
heaviness.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p5">6. He shook his raiment - To signify he would from that
time refrain from them: and to intimate, that God would soon shake them
off as unworthy to be numbered among his people. I am pure - None can
say this but he that has born a full testimony against sin. From
henceforth I will go to the Gentiles - But not to them altogether. He
did not break off all intercourse with the Jews even at Corinth. Only he
preached no more in their synagogue.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p6">7. He went into the house of one named Justus - A Gentile,
and preached there, though probably he still lodged with Aquila.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p7">8. And many hearing - The conversation of Crispus, and the
preaching of Paul.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p8">10. I am with thee: therefore fear not all the learning,
politeness, grandeur, or power of the inhabitants of this city. Speak
and hold not thy peace - For thy labour shall not be in vain. For I have
much people in this city - So he prophetically calls them that afterward
believed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p9">11. He continued there a year and six months - A long time!
But how few souls are now gained in a longer time than this? Who is in
the fault? Generally both teachers and hearers.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p10">12. When Gallio was proconsul of Achaia - Of which Corinth
was the chief city. This Gallio, the brother of the famous Seneca, is
much commended both by him and by other writers, for the sweetness and
generosity of his temper, and easiness of his behaviour. Yet one thing
he lacked! But he knew it not and had no concern about it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p11">15. But if it be - He speaks with the utmost coolness and
contempt, a question of names - The names of the heathen gods were
fables and shadows. But the question concerning the name of Jesus is of
more importance than all things else under heaven. Yet there is this
singularity (among a thousand others) in the Christian religion, that
human reason, curious as it is in all other things, abhors to inquire
into it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p12">17. Then they all took Sosthenes - The successor of
Crispus, and probably Paul's chief accuser, and beat him - It seems
because he had occasioned them so much trouble to no purpose, before the
judgment seat - One can hardly think in the sight of Gallio, though at
no great distance from him. And it seems to have had a happy effect. For
Sosthenes himself was afterward a Christian, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. i. 1" id="i.vi.xix-p12.1" parsed="|1Cor|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.1.1">1 Cor. i, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p13">18. Paul continued many days - After the year and six
months, to confirm the brethren. Aquila having shaved his head - As was
the custom in a vow, chap. xxi, 24; <scripRef passage="Num. vi. 18" id="i.vi.xix-p13.1" parsed="|Num|6|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.6.18">Num.
vi, 18</scripRef>. At Cenchrea - A seaport town, at a small distance from
Corinth.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p14">21. I must by all means keep the feast at Jerusalem - This
was not from any apprehension that he was obliged in conscience to keep
the Jewish feasts; but to take the opportunity of meeting a great number
of his countrymen to whom he might preach Christ, or whom he might
farther instruct, or free from the prejudices they had imbibed against
him. But I will return to you - So he did, chap. xix, 1.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p15">22. And landing at Cesarea, he went up - Immediately to
Jerusalem; and saluted the Church - Eminently so called, being the
mother Church of Christian believers: and having kept the feast there,
he went down from thence to Antioch.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p16">23. He went over the country of Galatia and Phrygia - It is
supposed, spending about four years therein, including the time he
stayed at Ephesus.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p17">24. An eloquent man, mighty in the Scriptures - Of the Old
Testament. Every talent may be of use in the kingdom of God, if joined
with the knowledge of the Scriptures and fervour of spirit.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p18">25. This man had been instructed - Though not perfectly, in
the way of the Lord - In the doctrine of Christ. Knowing only the
baptism of John - Only what John taught those whom he baptized, namely,
to repent and believe in a Messiah shortly to appear.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p19">26. He spake - Privately; and taught publicly. Probably he
returned to live at Alexandria, soon after he had been baptized by John;
and so had no opportunity of being fully acquainted with the doctrines
of the Gospel, as delivered by Christ and his apostles. And explained to
him the way of God more perfectly - He who knows Christ, is able to
instruct even those that are mighty in the Scriptures.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xix-p20">27. Who greatly helped through grace - It is through grace
only that any gift of any one is profitable to another. Them that had
believed - Apollos did not plant, but water. This was the peculiar gift
which he had received. And he was better able to convince the Jews, than
to convert the heathens.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="11.57%" prev="i.vi.xix" next="i.vi.xxi" id="i.vi.xx">
<h3 id="i.vi.xx-p0.1">XIX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XIX" id="i.vi.xx-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.19" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xx-p1">1. Having passed through - Galatia and Phrygia, which were
termed the upper parts of Asia Minor. Certain disciples - Who had been
formerly baptized by John the Baptist, and since imperfectly instructed
in Christianity.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p2">2. Have ye received the Holy Ghost? - The extraordinary
gifts of the Spirit, as well as his sanctifying graces? We have not so
much as heard - Whether there be any such gifts.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p3">3. Into what were ye baptized - Into what dispensation? To
the sealing of what doctrine? Into John's baptism - We were baptized by
John and believe what he taught.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p4">4. John baptized - That is, the whole baptism and preaching
of John pointed at Christ. After this John is mentioned no more in the
New Testament. Here he gives way to Christ altogether.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p5">5. And hearing this, they were baptized - By some other.
Paul only laid his hands upon them. They were baptized - They were
baptized twice; but not with the same baptism. John did not administer
that baptism which Christ afterward commanded, that is, in the name of
the Father, Son, and Holy Ghost.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p6">9. The way - The Christian way of worshipping God. He
departed - Leaving them their synagogue to themselves. Discoursing daily
- Not on the Sabbath only, in the school of one Tyrannus - Which we do
not find was any otherwise consecrated, than by preaching the Gospel
there.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p7">10. All who desired it among the inhabitants of the
proconsular Asia, now heard the word: St. Paul had been forbidden to
preach it in Asia before, chap. xvi, 6. But now the time was come.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p8">11. Special miracles - Wrought in a very uncommon
manner.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p9">12. Evil spirits - Who also occasioned many of those
diseases, which yet might appear to be purely natural.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p10">13. Exorcists - Several of the Jews about this time
pretended to a power of casting out devils, particularly by certain arts
or charms, supposed to be derived from Solomon. Undertook to name - Vain
undertaking! Satan laughs at all those who attempt to expel him either
out of the bodies or the souls of men but by Divine faith. All the light
of reason is nothing to the craft or strength of that subtle spirit. His
craft cannot be known but by the Spirit of God nor can his strength be
conquered but by the power of faith.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p11">17. And the name of the Lord Jesus was magnified - So that
even the malice of the devil wrought for the furtherance of the
Gospel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p12">18. Many came confessing - Of their own accord, and openly
declaring their deeds - The efficacy of God's word, penetrating the
inmost recesses of their soul, wrought that free and open confession to
which perhaps even torments would not have compelled them.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p13">19. Curious arts - Magical arts, to which that soft
appellation was given by those who practiced them. Ephesus was
peculiarly famous for these. And as these practices were of so much
reputation there, it is no wonder the books which taught them should
bear a great price. Bringing their books together - As it were by common
consent, burnt them - Which was far better than selling them, even
though the money had been given to the poor. Fifty thousand pieces of
silver - If these pieces of silver be taken for Jewish shekels, the sum
will amount to six thousand two hundred and fifty pounds.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p14">20. So powerfully did the word of God grow - In extent, and
prevail - In power and efficacy.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p15">21. After these things were ended - Paul sought not to
rest, but pressed on, as if he had yet done nothing. He is already
possessed of Ephesus and Asia. He purposes for Macedonia and Achaia. He
has his eye upon Jerusalem, then upon Rome; afterward on Spain, <scripRef passage="Rom. xv. 28" id="i.vi.xx-p15.1" parsed="|Rom|15|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.15.28">Rom. xv, 28</scripRef>. No Caesar, no Alexander the Great, no other hero, comes up
to the magnanimity of this little Benjamite. Faith and love to God and
man had enlarged his heart, even as the sand of the sea.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p16">24. Silver shrines - Silver models of that famous temple,
which were bought not only by the citizens, but by strangers from all
parts. The artificers - The other silversmiths.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p17">25. The workmen - Employed by him and them.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p18">26. Saying, that they are not gods which are made with
hands - This manifestly shows, that the contrary opinion did then
generally prevail, namely, that there was a real Divinity in their
sacred images. Though some of the later heathens spoke of them just as
the Romanists do now.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p19">27. There is danger, not only that this our craft [trade]
should come into disgrace, but also that the temple of the great goddess
Diana should be despised - No wonder a discourse should make so deep an
impression, which was edged both by interest and superstition. The great
goddess was one of the standing titles of Diana. Her majesty destroyed -
Miserable majesty, which was capable of being thus destroyed! Whom all
Asia and the world - That is, the Roman empire, worshippeth - Although
under a great variety of titles and characters. But the multitude of
those that err does not turn error into truth.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p20">29. They rushed with one accord - Demetrius and his
company, into the theatre - Where criminals were wont to be thrown to
the wild beasts, dragging with them Gaius and Aristarchus - When they
could not find Paul. Probably they hoped to oblige them to fight with
the wild beasts, as some think St. Paul had done before.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p21">30. When Paul would have gone in to the people - Being
above all fear, to plead the cause of his companions, and prove they are
not gods which are made with hands.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p22">31. The principal officers of Asia - The Asian priests, who
presided over the public games, which they were then celebrating in
honour of Diana.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p23">32. The greater part did not know for what they were come
together - Which is commonly the case in such an assembly.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p24">33. And they thrust forward - Namely, the artificers and
workmen, Alexander - Probably some well-known Christian whom they saw in
the crowd: the Jews pushing him on - To expose him to the more danger.
And Alexander waving with his hand - In token of desiring silence, would
have made a defense - For himself and his brethren.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p25">34. But when they knew that he was a Jew - And consequently
an enemy to their worship of images; they prevented him, by crying,
Great is Diana of the Ephesians.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p26">35. The register - Probably the chief governor of the
public games. The image which fell down from Jupiter - They believed
that very image of Diana, which stood in her temple, fell down from
Jupiter in heaven. Perhaps he designed to insinuate, as if falling down
from Jupiter, it was not made with hands, and so was not that sort of
idols which Paul had said were no gods.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p27">37. Nor blasphemers of your goddess - They simply declared
the one God, and the vanity of idols in general.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p28">38. There are proconsuls - One in every province. There was
one at Ephesus.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p29">39. In a lawful assembly - In such a regular assembly as
has authority to judge of religious and political affairs.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xx-p30">40. This concourse - He wisely calls it by an inoffensive
name.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="11.69%" prev="i.vi.xx" next="i.vi.xxii" id="i.vi.xxi">
<h3 id="i.vi.xxi-p0.1">XX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XX" id="i.vi.xxi-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.20" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p1">1. After the tumult was ceased - So Demetrius gained
nothing. Paul remained there till all was quiet.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p2">2. He came into Greece - That part of it which lay between
Macedonia and Achaia.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p3">3. An ambush being laid for him - In his way to the
ship.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p4">4. To Asia - There some of them left him. But Trophimus
went with him to Jerusalem, chap. xxi, 29. Aristarchus, even to Rome,. xxvii, 2.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p5">6. We set sail - St. Luke was now with St. Paul again, as
we learn from his manner of expressing himself.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p6">7. To break bread - That is, to celebrate the Lord's
Supper; continued his discourse - Through uncommon fervour of
spirit.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p7">8. There were many lamps in the room where they were
assembled - To prevent any possible scandal.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p8">9. In the window - Doubtless kept open, to prevent heat,
both from the lamps and the number of people.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p9">10. Paul fell or him - It is observable, our Lord never
used this gesture. But Elijah and Elisha did as well as Paul. His life
is in him - He is alive again.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p10">11. So departed - Without taking any rest at all.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p11">12. And they brought the young man alive - But alas! How
many of those who have allowed themselves to sleep under sermons, or as
it were to dream awake, have slept the sleep of eternal death, and
fallen to rise no more!</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p12">13. Being himself to go on foot - That he might enjoy the
company of his Christian brethren a little longer, although he had
passed the night without sleep, and though Assos was of difficult and
dangerous access by land.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p13">14. Mitylene - Was a city and part of the isle of Lesbos,
about seven miles distant from the Asiatic coast.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p14">16. For Paul had determined to sail by Ephesus - Which lay
on the other side of the bay. He hasted to be at Jerusalem on the day of
pentecost - Because then was the greatest concourse of people.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p15">17. Sending to Ephesus, he called the elders of the Church
- These are called bishops in the 28th verse, (rendered overseers in our
translation.) Perhaps elders and bishops were then the same; or no
otherwise different than are the rector of a parish and his curates.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p16">18. Ye know - Happy is he who can thus appeal to the
conscience of his hearers.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p17">19. Serving - See the picture of a faithful servant! The
Lord - Whose the church is, with all humility, and with tears, and
trials - These are the concomicants of it. The service itself is
described more particularly in the following verse. This humility he
recommends to the Ephesians themselves, <scripRef passage="Eph. iv. 2" id="i.vi.xxi-p17.1" parsed="|Eph|4|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.4.2">Eph. iv, 2</scripRef>. His tears are mentioned again, verse 31, as also <scripRef passage="2 Cor. ii. 4" id="i.vi.xxi-p17.2" parsed="|2Cor|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.2.4">2 Cor. ii,
4</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Phil. iii. 18" id="i.vi.xxi-p17.3" parsed="|Phil|3|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.3.18">Phil. iii,
18</scripRef>. These passages laid together supply us with the genuine
character of St. Paul. Holy tears, from those who seldom weep on account
of natural occurrences, are no mean specimen of the efficacy and proof
of the truth of Christianity. Yet joy is well consistent therewith, ver.
24. The same person may be sorrowful, yet always rejoicing.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p18">20. I have preached - Publicly; and taught - From house to
house. Else he had not been pure from their blood. For even an apostle
could not discharge his duty by public preaching only. How much less can
an ordinary pastor!</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p19">21. Repentance toward God - The very first motion of the
soul toward God is a kind of repentance.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p20">22. Bound by the Spirit - Strongly impelled by him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p21">23. Save that - Only this I know in general; the Holy Ghost
witnesseth - By other persons. Such was God's good pleasure to reveal
these things to him, not immediately, but by the ministry of others.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p22">24. Nor do I count my life precious - It adds great force
to this and all the other passages of Scripture, in which the apostles
express their contempt of the world, that they were not uttered by
persons like Seneca and Antoninus, who talked elegantly of despising the
world in the full affluence of all its enjoyments; but by men who daily
underwent the greatest calamities, and exposed their lives in proof of
their assertions.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p23">25. Ye shall see my face no more - He wisely inserts this,
that what follows might make the deeper impression.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p24">27. For I have not shunned - Otherwise if any had perished,
their blood would have been on his head.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p25">28. Take heed therefore - I now devolve my care upon you;
first to yourselves; then to the flock over which the Holy Ghost hath
made you overseers - For no man, or number of men upon earth, can
constitute an overseer, bishop, or any other Christian minister. To do
this is the peculiar work of the Holy Ghost: to feed the Church of God -
That is, the believing, loving, holy children of God; which he hath
purchased - How precious is it then in his sight! with his own blood -
For it is the blood of the only begotten Son of God, <scripRef passage="1 John i. 7" id="i.vi.xxi-p25.1" parsed="|1John|1|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.1.7">1 John i, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p26">29. Grievous wolves - From without, namely, false apostles.
They had, not yet broke in on the Church at Ephesus.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p27">30. Yea, from among yourselves men will arise - Such were
the Nicolaitans, of whom Christ complains, <scripRef passage="Rev. ii. 6" id="i.vi.xxi-p27.1" parsed="|Rev|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.2.6">Rev. ii, 6</scripRef>; to draw away disciples - From the purity of the Gospel and
the unity of the body.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p28">31. I ceased not to warn every one night and day - This was
watching indeed! Who copies after this example?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p29">32. The word of his grace - It is the grand channel of it,
to believers as well as unbelievers. Who is able to build you up - To
confirm and increase your faith, love, holiness. God can thus build us
up, without any instrument. But he does build us up by them. O beware of
dreaming that you have less need of human teachers after you know Christ
than before! And to give you an inheritance - Of eternal glory, among
them that are sanctified - And so made meet for it. A large number of
these Paul doubtless knew, and remembered before God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p30">33. I have coveted - Here the apostle begins the other
branch of his farewell discourse, like old Samuel, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xii. 3" id="i.vi.xxi-p30.1" parsed="|1Sam|12|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.12.3">1 Sam. xii, 3</scripRef>, taking his leave of the children of Israel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p31">34. These hands - Callous, as you see, with labour. Who is
he that envies such a bishop or archbishop as this?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p32">35. I have showed you - Bishops, by my example, all things
- And this among the rest; that thus labouring - So far as the labours
of your office allow you time; ye ought to help the weak - Those who are
disabled by sickness, or any bodily infirmity, from maintaining
themselves by their own labour. And to remember - Effectually, so as to
follow it; the word which he himself said - Without doubt his disciples
remembered many of his words which are not recorded. It is happier to
give - To imitate God, and have him, as it were, indebted to us.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p33">37. They all wept - Of old, men, yea, the best and bravest
of men, were easily melted into tears; a thousand instances of which
might be produced from profane as well as sacred writers. But now,
notwithstanding the effeminacy which almost universally prevails, we
leave those tears to women and children.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxi-p34">38. Sorrowing most for that word which he spake, that they
should see his face no more - What sorrow will be in the great day, when
God shall speak that word to all who are found on the left hand, that
they shall see his face no more!</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="11.82%" prev="i.vi.xxi" next="i.vi.xxiii" id="i.vi.xxii">
<h3 id="i.vi.xxii-p0.1">XXI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XXI" id="i.vi.xxii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.21" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p1">1. And when we were torn away from the in - Not without
doing violence both to ourselves and them.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p2">3. We landed at Tyre - That there should be Christians
there was foretold, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxxvii. 4" id="i.vi.xxii-p2.1" parsed="|Ps|87|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.87.4">Psalm lxxxvii,
4</scripRef>. What we read in that Psalm of the Philistines and
Ethiopians also may be compared with chap. viii, 40; xxvii, 4.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p3">4. And finding disciples, we tarried there seven days - ln
order to spend a Sabbath with them. Who told Paul by the Spirit - That
afflictions awaited him at Jerusalem. This was properly what they said
by the Spirit. They themselves advised him not to go up. The disciples
seemed to understand their prophetic impulse to be an intimation from
the Spirit, that Paul, if he were so minded, might avoid the danger, by
not going to Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p4">7. Having finished our voyage - From Macedonia, chap. xx,
6, we came to Ptolemais - A celebrated city on the sea coast, anciently
called Accos. It is now, like many other once noble cities, only a heap
of ruins.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p5">8. We came to Cesarea - So called from a stately temple
which Herod the Great dedicated there to Augustus Caesar. It was the
place where the Roman governor of Judea generally resided and kept his
court. The evangelist, who was one of the seven deacons - An evangelist
is a preacher of the Gospel to those who had never heard it, as Philip
had done to the Samaritans, to the Ethiopian eunuch, and to all the
towns from Azotus to Cesarea, chap. viii, 5, 26, 40. It is not unlikely
he spent the following years preaching in Tyre and Sidon, and the other
heathen cities in the neighbourhood of Galilee, his house being at
Cesarea, a convenient situation for that purpose. We abode with him - We
lodged at his house during our stay at Cesarea.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p6">10. A certain prophet came - The nearer the event was, the
more expressed were the predictions which prepared Paul for it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p7">11. Binding his own feet and hands - In the manner that
malefactors were wont to be bound when apprehended. So shall the Jews
bind the man whose girdle this is - St. Paul's bonds were first
particularly foretold at Cesarea, to which he afterward came in bonds,
chap. xxiii, 33.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p8">12. Both we, (his fellow travelers,) and they of the place,
besought him not to go up to Jerusalem - St. Paul knew that this
prediction had the force of a command. They did not know this.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p9">13. Breaking my heart - For the apostles themselves were
not void of human affections. I am ready not only to be bound, but to
die - And to him that is ready for it, the burden is light.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p10">14. And when he would not be persuaded - This was not
obstinacy, but true Christian resolution. We should never be persuaded,
either to do evil, or to omit doing any good which is in our power;
saying, the will of the Lord be done - Which they were satisfied Paul
knew.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p11">15. We took up our carriages - Our baggage; which probably
went by sea before. What they took with them now in particular was the
alms they were carrying to Jerusalem, chap. xxiv, 17.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p12">16. The disciples brought us to one Mnason, a Cyprian, an
old disciple - He was a native of Cyprus, but an inhabitant of
Jerusalem, and probably one of the first converts there.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p13">18. Paul went in with us - That it might appear we are all
of one mind, to James - Commonly called the Lord's brother; the only
apostle then presiding over the Churches in Judea.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p14">20. They are all zealous for the law - For the whole Mosaic
dispensation. How astonishing is this! Did none of the apostles, beside
St. Paul, know that this dispensation was now abolished? And if they did
both know and testify this, how came their hearers not to believe
them?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p15">21. They have been informed concerning thee, that thou
teachest the Jews - not to circumcise their children, nor to walk after
the customs - Of the Mosaic law. And so undoubtedly he did. And so he
wrote to all the Churches in Galatia, among whom were many Jews. Yea,
and James himself had long before assented to Peter, affirming before
all the apostles and all the brethren, chap. xv, 10, That this very law
was a yoke which (said he) neither our fathers nor we were able to bear
- Amazing! that they did not know this! Or, that if they did, they did
not openly testify it at all hazards, to every Jewish convert in
Jerusalem!</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p16">22. What is it therefore - What is to be done? The
multitude must needs come together - They will certainly gather together
in a tumultuous manner, unless they be some way pacified.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p17">23. Therefore - To obviate their prejudice against thee: do
this that we say to thee - Doubtless they meant this advice well: but
could Paul follow it in godly sincerity? Was not the yielding so far to
the judgment of others too great a deference to be paid to any mere
men?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p18">24. And all will know - that thou thyself walkest orderly,
keeping the law - Ought he not, without any reverence to man, where the
truth of God was so deeply concerned, to have answered plainly, I do not
keep the Mosaic law; neither need any of you. Yea, Peter doth not keep
the law. And God himself expressly commanded him not to keep it;
ordering him to go in to men uncircumcised, and to eat with them, chap.
xi, 3, which the law utterly forbids.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p19">26. Then Paul took the men - Yielding his own judgment to
their advice, which seemed to flow not out of spiritual but carnal
wisdom; seeming to be what he really was not: making as if he believed
the law still in force. Declaring - Giving notice to the priests in
waiting, that he designed to accomplish the days of purification, till
all the sacrifice should be offered, as the Mosaic law required, <scripRef passage="Num. vi. 13" id="i.vi.xxii-p19.1" parsed="|Num|6|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.6.13">Num. vi, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p20">27. And when the seven days were about to be accomplished -
When after giving notice to the priests, they were entering upon the
accomplishment of those days. It was toward the beginning of them that
Paul was seized. The Jews that were from Asia - Some of those Jews who
came from Asia to the feast.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p21">28. Against the people - The Jewish nation; and the law -
Of Moses; and this place - The temple. Yea, and hath even brought Greeks
into the temple - They might come into the outer court. But they
imagined Paul had brought then into the inner temple, and had thereby
polluted it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p22">30. And immediately the gates were shut - Both to prevent
any further violation of the temple; and to prevent Paul's taking
sanctuary at the horns of the altar.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p23">31. And as they went about to kill him - It was a rule
among the Jews, that any uncircumcised person who came into the inner
temple, might be stoned without farther process. And they seemed to
think Paul, who brought such in thither, deserved no better treatment.
Word came to the tribune - A cohort or detachment of soldiers, belonging
to the Roman legion, which lodged in the adjacent castle of Antonia,
were stationed on feast days near the temple, to prevent disorders. It
is evident, Lysias himself was not present, when the tumult began.
Probably he was the oldest Roman tribune (or colonel) then at Jerusalem.
And as such he was the commanding officer of the legion quartered at the
castle.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p24">33. Then the tribune - Having made his way through the
multitude, came near and took him - And how many great ends of
providence were answered by this imprisonment? This was not only a means
of preserving his life, (after he had suffered severely for worldly
prudence,) but gave him an opportunity of preaching the Gospel safely,
in spite of all tumult, chap. xxii, 22, yea, and that in those places to
which otherwise he could have had no access, verse 40. And commanded him
to be bound with two chains - Taking it for granted he was some
notorious offender. And thus the prophecy of Agabus was fulfilled,
though by the hands of a Roman.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p25">35. When he came upon the stairs - The castle of Antonia
was situate on a rock fifty cubits high, at that corner of the outward
temple, where the western and northern porticos joined, to each of which
there were stairs descending from it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p26">37. As Paul was about to be brought into the castle - The
wisdom of God taught to make use of that very time and place.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p27">38. Art not thou that Egyptian - Who came into Judea when
Felix had been some years governor there! Calling himself a prophet, he
drew much people after him; and having brought them through the
wilderness, led them to Mount Olivet, promising that the walls of the
city should fall down before them. But Felix marching out of Jerusalem
against him, his followers quickly dispersed, many of whom were taken or
slain; but he himself made his escape.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxii-p28">40. In the Hebrew tongue - That dialect of it, which was
then commonly spoken at Jerusalem.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="11.97%" prev="i.vi.xxii" next="i.vi.xxiv" id="i.vi.xxiii">
<h3 id="i.vi.xxiii-p0.1">XXII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XXII" id="i.vi.xxiii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.22" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p1">1. Hear ye now my defense - Which they could not hear
before for the tumult.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p2">3. I am verily - This defense answers all that is objected,
chap. xxi, 28. As there, so here also mention is made of the person of
Paul, ver. 3, of the people and the law, ver. 3, 5, 12; of the temple,
ver. 17; of teaching all men, ver. 15-17, 21; and of the truth of his
doctrine, ver. 6. But he speaks closely and nervously, in few words,
because the time was short. But brought up at the feet of Gamaliel - The
scholars usually sat on low seats, or upon mats on the floor, at the
feet of their masters, whose seats were raised to a considerable height.
Accurately instructed - The learned education which Paul had received
was once no doubt the matter of his boasting and confidence.
Unsanctified learning made his bonds strong, and furnished him with
numerous arguments against the Gospel. Yet when the grace of God had
changed his heart, and turned his accomplishments into another channel,
he was the fitter instrument to serve God's wise and merciful purposes,
in the defense and propagation of Christianity.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p3">4. And persecuted this way - With the same zeal that you do
now. Binding both men and women - How much better was his condition, now
he was bound himself.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p4">5. The high priest is my witness - Is able to testify. The
brethren -- Jews: so this title was not peculiar to the Christians.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p5">6. About noon - All was done in the face of the sun. A
great light shone - By whatever method God reveals himself to us, we
shall have everlasting cause to recollect it with pleasure. Especially
when he has gone in any remarkable manner out of his common way for this
gracious purpose. If so, we should often dwell on the particular
circumstances, and be ready, on every proper occasion, to recount those
wonders of power and love, for the encouragement and instruction of
others.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p6">9. They did not hear the voice - Distinctly; but only a
confused noise.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p7">12. A devout man according to the law - A truly religious
person, and though a believer in Christ, yet a strict observer of the
law of Moses.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p8">16. Be baptized, and wash away thy sins - Baptism
administered to real penitents, is both a means and seal of pardon. Nor
did God ordinarily in the primitive Church bestow this on any, unless
through this means.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p9">17. When I was returned to Jerusalem - From Damascus, and
was praying in the temple - Whereby he shows that he still paid the
temple its due honour, as the house of prayer. I was in a trance -
Perhaps he might continue standing all the while, so that any who were
near him would hardly discern it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p10">18. And I saw him - Jesus, saying to me, Depart quickly out
of Jerusalem - Because of the snares laid for thee: and in order to
preach where they will hear.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p11">19. And I said - It is not easy for a servant of Christ,
who is himself deeply impressed with Divine truths, to imagine to what a
degree men are capable of hardening their hearts against thee. He is
often ready to think with Paul, It is impossible for any to resist such
evidence. But experience makes him wiser and shows that wilful unbelief
is proof against all truth and reason.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p12">20. When the blood of thy martyr Stephen was shed, I also
was standing by - A real convert still retains the remembrance of his
former sins. He confesses thorn and is humbled for them, all the days of
his life.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p13">22. And they heard him to this word - Till he began to
speak of his mission to the Gentiles, and this too in such a manner as
implied that the Jews were in danger of being cast off.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p14">23. They rent their garments - In token of indignation and
horror at this pretended blasphemy, and cast dust into the air - Through
vehemence of rage, which they knew not how to vent.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p15">25. And as they - The soldiers ordered by the tribune, were
binding him with thongs - A freeman of Rome might be bound with a chain
and beaten with a staff: but he might not be bound with thongs, neither
scourged, or beaten with rods: Paul said to the centurion - The captain,
who stood by to see the orders of the tribune executed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p16">26. Consider what thou art about to do; for this man is a
Roman - Yea, there was a stronger reason to consider. For this man was a
servant of God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiii-p17">28. But I was free born - Not barely as being born at
Tarsus; for this was not Roman colony. But probably either his father,
or some of his ancestors, had been made free of Rome, for some military
service. We learn hence, that we are under no obligation as Christians
to give up our civil privileges (which we are to receive and prize as
the gift of God) to every insolent invader. In a thousand circumstances,
gratitude to God, and duty to men, will oblige us to insist upon them;
and engage us to strive to transmit them improved, rather than impaired
to posterity.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="12.05%" prev="i.vi.xxiii" next="i.vi.xxv" id="i.vi.xxiv">
<h3 id="i.vi.xxiv-p0.1">XXIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XXIII" id="i.vi.xxiv-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.23" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p1">1. And Paul earnestly beholding the council - Professing a
clear conscience by his very countenance; and likewise waiting to see
whether any of them was minded to ask him any question, said, I have
lived in all good conscience before God till this day - He speaks
chiefly of the time since he became a Christian. For none questioned him
concerning what he had been before. And yet even in his unconverted
state, although he was in an error, yet he had acted from conscience,
before God - Whatever men may think or say of me.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p2">3. Then said Paul - Being carried away by a sudden and
prophetic impulse. God is about to smite thee, thou whited wall - Fair
without; full of dirt and rubbish within. And he might well be so
termed, not only as he committed this outrage, while gravely sitting on
the tribunal of justice but also as, at the same time that he stood high
in the esteem of the citizens, he cruelly defrauded the priests of their
legal subsistence, so that some of them even perished for want. And God
did remarkably smite him; for about five years after this, his house
being reduced to ashes, in a tumult begun by his own son, he was
besieged in the royal palace; where having hid himself in an old
aqueduct, he was dragged out and miserably slain.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p3">5. I was not aware, brethren, that it was the high priest -
He seems to mean, I did not advert to it, in the prophetic transport of
my mind: but he does not add, that his not adverting to it proceeded
from the power of the Spirit coming upon him; as knowing they were not
able to bear it. This answer admirably shows the situation of mind he
was then in, partly with regard to the bystanders, whom he thus softens,
adding also the title of brethren, and justifying their reproof by the
prohibition of Moses; partly with regard to himself, who, after that
singular transport subsided, was again under the direction of the
general command. <scripRef passage="Exod. xxii. 28" id="i.vi.xxiv-p3.1" parsed="|Exod|22|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.22.28">Exod. xxii,
28</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p4">6. I am a Pharisee, the son of a Pharisee: for the hope of
the resurrection of the dead am I called in question - So he was in
effect; although not formally, or explicitly.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p5">8. The Pharisees confess both - Both the resurrection, and
the existence of angels and separate spirits.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p6">9. And the scribes of the Pharisees' side arising - Every
sect contains both learned and unlearned. The former used to be the
mouth of the party. If a spirit - St. Paul in his speech from the stairs
had affirmed, that Jesus, whom they knew to have been dead, was alive,
and that he had spoken to him from heaven, and again in a vision. So
they add nothing, only they construe it in their own way, putting an
angel or spirit for Jesus.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p7">11. And the night following, the Lord Jesus - What Paul had
before purposed in spirit, chap. xix, 21, God now in due time confirms.
Another declaration to the same effect is made by an angel of God, chap.
xxvii, 23. And from the 23rd chapter the sum of this book turns on the
testimony of Paul to the Romans. How would the defenders of St. Peter's
supremacy triumph, could they find out half as much ascribed to him! Be
of good courage, Paul - As he laboured under singular distresses and
persecutions, so he was favoured with extraordinary assurances of the
Divine assistance. Thou must testify - Particular promises are usually
given when all things appear desperate. At Rome also - Danger is nothing
in the eyes of God: all hindrances farther his work. A promise of what
is afar off, implies all that necessarily lies between. Paul shall
testify at Rome: therefore he shall come to Rome; therefore he shall
escape the Jews, the sea, the viper.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p8">12. Some of the Jews bound themselves - Such execrable vows
were not uncommon among the Jews. And if they were prevented from
accomplishing what they had vowed, it was an easy matter to obtain
absolution from their rabbis.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p9">15. Now therefore ye - Which they never scrupled at all, as
not doubting but they were doing God service.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p10">17. And Paul - Though he had an express promise of it from
Christ, was not to neglect any proper means of safety.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p11">19. And the tribune taking him by the hand - In a mild,
condescending way. Lysias seems to have conducted this whole affair with
great integrity, humanity, and prudence.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p12">24. Provide beasts - If a change should be necessary, to
set Paul on - So we read of his riding once; but not by choice.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p13">27. Having learned that he was a Roman - True; but not
before he rescued him. Here he uses art.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p14">31. The soldiers brought him by night to Antipatris - But
not the same night they set out. For Antipatris was about thirty-eight
of our miles northwest of Jerusalem. Herod the Great rebuilt it, and
gave it this name in honour of his father Antipater: Cesarea was near
seventy miles from Jerusalem, and about thirty from Antipatris.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxiv-p15">35. In Herod's palace - This was a palace and a court built
by Herod the Great. Probably some tower belonging to it might be used
for a kind of state prison.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="12.14%" prev="i.vi.xxiv" next="i.vi.xxvi" id="i.vi.xxv">
<h3 id="i.vi.xxv-p0.1">XXIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XXIV" id="i.vi.xxv-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.24" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p1">1. Ananias - Who would spare no trouble on the occasion,
with several of the elders, members of the sanhedrim.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p2">2. Tertullus began - A speech how different from St.
Paul's; which is true, modest, solid, and without paint. Felix was a man
of the most infamous character, and a plague to all the provinces over
which he presided.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p3">4. But that I may not trouble thee any further - By
trespassing either on thy patience or modesty. The eloquence of
Tertullus was as bad as his cause: a lame introduction, a lame
transition, and a lame conclusion. Did not God confound the orator's
language?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p4">10. Knowing - for several years thou hast been a judge over
this nation - And so not unacquainted with our religious rites and
customs, and consequently more capable of understanding and deciding a
cause of this nature. There was no flattery in this. It was a plain
fact. He governed Judea six or seven years. I answer for myself - As it
may be observed, his answer exactly corresponds with the three articles
of Tertullus's charge: sedition, heresy, and profanation of the temple.
As to the first, he suggests, that he had not been long enough at
Jerusalem to form a party and attempt an insurrection: (for it was about
twelve days since he came up thither; five of which he had been at
Cesarea, ver. 1; one or two were spent in his journey thither, and most
of the rest he had been confined at Jerusalem.) And he challenges them,
in fact, to produce any evidence of such practices, ver. 11-13. As to
the second, he confesses himself to be a Christian; but maintains this
to be a religion perfectly agreeable to the law and the prophets, and
therefore deserving a fair reception, ver. 14, 16. And as for profaning
the temple, he observes that he behaved there in a most peaceful and
regular manner, so that his innocence had been manifest even before the
sanhedrim, where the authors of the tumult did not dare to appear
against him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p5">14. After the way which they call heresy - This appellation
St. Paul corrects. Not that it was then an odious word; but it was not
honourable enough. A party or sect (so that word signifies) is formed by
men. This way was prescribed by God. The apostle had now said what was
sufficient for his defense; but having a fair occasion, he makes an
ingenuous confession of his faith in this verse, his hope in the next,
his love in the 17th. verse.So worship I the God of my fathers
- This was a very proper plea before a Roman magistrate; as it proved
that he was under the protection of the Roman laws, since the Jews were
so: whereas had he introduced the worship of new gods he would have
forfeited that protection. Believing all things which are written -
Concerning the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p6">15. Both of the just and of the unjust - In a public court
this was peculiarly proper to be observed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p7">16. For this cause - With a view to this, I also exercise
myself - As well as they.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p8">19. Who ought to have been present before thee - But the
world never commit greater blunders, even against its own laws, than
when it is persecuting the children of God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p9">21. Unless they think me blamable for this one word - Which
nevertheless was the real truth. chap. xxiii, 6.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p10">22. After I have been more accurately informed - Which he
afterward was; and he doubtless (as well as Festus and Agrippa)
transmitted a full account of these things to Rome.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p11">23. He commanded the centurion to let him have liberty - To
be only a prisoner at large. Hereby the Gospel was spread more and more;
not to the satisfaction of the Jews. But they could not hinder it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p12">24. And after Paul had been kept some days in this gentle
confinement at Cesarea, Felix, who had been absent for a short time,
coming thither again, with Drusilla, his wife - The daughter of Herod
Agrippa, one of the finest women of that age. Felix persuaded her to
forsake her husband, Azizus, king of Emessa, and to be married to
himself, though a heathen. She was afterward, with a son she had by
Felix, consumed in an eruption of Mount Vesuvius. Concerning the faith
in Christ - That is, the doctrine of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p13">25. And as he reasoned of justice, temperance, and judgment
to come - This was the only effectual way of preaching Christ to an
unjust, lewd judge. Felix being terrified - How happily might this
conviction have ended, had he been careful to pursue the views which
were then opening upon his mind! But, like thousands, he deferred the
consideration of these things to a more convenient season. A season
which, alas! never came. For though he heard again, he was terrified no
more. In the meantime we do not find Drusilla, though a Jewess, was thus
alarmed. She had been used to hear of a future judgment: perhaps too she
trusted to the being a daughter of Abraham, or to the expiation of the
law, and so was proof against the convictions which seized on her
husband, though a heathen. Let this teach us to guard against all such
false dependencies as tend to elude those convictions that might
otherwise be produced in us by the faithful preaching of the word of
God. Let us stop our ears against those messengers of Satan, who appear
as angels of light; who would teach us to reconcile the hope of
salvation with a corrupt heart or an unholy life. Go thy way for this
time - O how will every damned soul one day lament his having neglected
such a time as this!</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p14">26. He hoped also - An evil hope: so when he heard his eye
was not single. No marvel then that he profited nothing by all St.
Paul's discourses: that money would be given - By the Christians for the
liberty of so able a minister. And waiting for this, unhappy Felix fell
short of the treasure of the Gospel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxv-p15">27. But after two years - After St. Paul had been two years
a prisoner, Felix desiring to gratify the Jews, left Paul bound - Thus
men of the world, to gratify one another, stretch forth their hands to
the things of God! Yet the wisdom of Felix did not profit him, did not
satisfy the Jews at all. Their accusations followed him to Rome, and had
utterly ruined him, but for the interest which his brother Pallas had
with Nero.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="12.24%" prev="i.vi.xxv" next="i.vi.xxvii" id="i.vi.xxvi">
<h3 id="i.vi.xxvi-p0.1">XXV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XXV" id="i.vi.xxvi-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.25" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p1">2. Then the high priest and the chief of the Jews appeared
against Paul - In so long a time their rage was not cooled. So much
louder a call had Paul to the Gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p2">4. But Festus answered - So Festus's care to preserve the
imperial privileges was the means of preserving Paul's life. By what
invisible springs does God govern the world! With what silence, and yet
with what wisdom and energy!</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p3">5. Let those of you who are able - Who are best able to
undertake the journey, and to manage the cause. If there be any
wickedness in him - So he does not pass sentence before he hears the
cause.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p4">6. Not more than ten days - A short space for a new
governor to stay at such a city as Jerusalem. He could not with any
convenience have heard and decided the cause of Paul within that
time.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p5">7. Bringing many accusations - When many accusations are
heaped together, frequently not one of them is true.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p6">8. While he answered - To a general charge a general answer
was sufficient.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p7">9. Art thou willing to go up to Jerusalem - Festus could
have ordered this without asking Paul. But God secretly overruled the
whole, that he might have an occasion of appealing to Rome.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p8">10. I am standing at Caesar's judgment seat - For all the
courts of the Roman governors were held in the name of the emperor, and
by commission from him. No man can give me up - He expresses it
modestly: the meaning is, Thou canst not. I appeal to Caesar - Which any
Roman citizen might do before sentence was passed.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p9">12. The council - It was customary for a considerable
number of persons of distinction to attend the Roman governors. These
constituted a kind of council, with whom they frequently advised.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p10">13. Agrippa - The son of Herod Agrippa, chap. xii, 1; and
Bernice - His sister, with whom he lived in a scandalous familiarity.
This was the person whom Titus Vespasian so passionately loved, that he
would have made her empress, had not the clamours of the Roman prevented
it.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p11">15. Desiring judgment against him - As upon a previous
conviction, which they falsely pretended.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p12">16. It is not the custom of the Roman - How excellent a
rule, to condemn no one unheard! A rule, which as it is common to all
nations, (courts of inquisition only excepted,) so it ought to direct
our proceedings in all affairs, not only in public, but private
life.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p13">18. Such things as I supposed - From their passion and
vehemence.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p14">19. But had certain questions - How coldly does he mention
the things of the last importance! And about one Jesus - Thus does
Festus speak of Him, to whom every knee shall bow! Whom Paul affirmed to
be alive - And was this a doubtful question? But why, O Festus, didst
thou doubt concerning it? Only because thou didst not search into the
evidence of it. Otherwise that evidence might have opened to thee, till
it had grown up into full conviction; and thy illustrious prisoner have
led thee into the glorious liberty of the children of God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvi-p15">23. With the tribunes and principal men of the city - The
chief officers, both military and civil.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="12.30%" prev="i.vi.xxvi" next="i.vi.xxviii" id="i.vi.xxvii">
<h3 id="i.vi.xxvii-p0.1">XXVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XXVI" id="i.vi.xxvii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.26" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p1">And Paul stretching forth his hand - Chained as it was: a
decent expression of his own earnestness, and proper to engage the
attention of his hearers; answered for himself - Not only refuting the
accusations of the Jews, but enlarging upon the faith of the Gospel.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p2">2. King Agrippa - There is a peculiar force in thus
addressing a person by name. Agrippa felt this.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p3">3. Who art accurately acquainted - Which Festus was not;
with the customs - In practical matters; and questions - In speculative.
This word Festus had used in the absence of Paul, chap. xxv, 19, who, by
the Divine leading, repeats and explains it. Agrippa had had peculiar
advantages for an accurate knowledge of the Jewish customs and
questions, from his education under his father Herod, and his long abode
at Jerusalem. Nothing can be imagined more suitable or more graceful,
than this whole discourse of Paul before Agrippa; in which the
seriousness of the Christian, the boldness of the apostle, and the
politeness of the gentleman and the scholar, appear in a most beautiful
contrast, or rather a most happy union.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p4">4. From my youth, which was from the beginning - That is,
which was from the beginning of my youth.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p5">5. If they would testify - But they would not, for they
well knew what weight his former life must add to his present
testimony.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p6">6. And now - This and the two following verses are in a
kind of ver. 6, 7, 8 parenthesis, and show that what the Pharisees
rightly taught concerning the resurrection, Paul likewise asserted at
this day. The ninth verse is connected with the fifth. For Pharisaism
ver. 9, 5 impelled him to persecute. I stand in judgment for the hope of
the promise - Of the resurrection. So it was in effect. For unless
Christ had risen, there could have been no resurrection of the dead. And
it was chiefly for testifying the resurrection of Christ, that the Jews
still persecuted him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p7">7. Our twelve tribes - For a great part of the ten tribes
also had at various times returned from the east to their own country, <scripRef passage="James i. 1" id="i.vi.xxvii-p7.1" parsed="|Jas|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.1.1">James i, 1</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="1 Pet. i. 1" id="i.vi.xxvii-p7.2" parsed="|1Pet|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.1.1">1 Pet. i,
1</scripRef>. Worshipping continually night and day - That is, this is
what they aim at in all their public and private worship.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p8">8. Is it judged by you an incredible thing - It was by
Festus, chap. xxv, 19, to whom Paul answers as if he had heard him
discourse.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p9">9. I thought - When I was a Pharisee: that I ought to do
many things - Which he now enumerates.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p10">10. I shut up many of the saints - Men not only innocent,
but good, just, holy. I gave my vote against them - That is, I joined
with those who condemned them. Perhaps the chief priests did also give
him power to vote on these occasions.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p11">11. I compelled them - That is, some of them; to blaspheme
- This is the most dreadful of all! Repent, ye enemies of the Gospel. If
Spira, who was compelled, suffered so terribly, what will become of
those who compel, like Saul, but do not repent like him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p12">12. <scripRef passage="Acts ix. 2" id="i.vi.xxvii-p12.1" parsed="|Acts|9|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.9.2">Acts ix,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p13">13. O King - Most seasonably, in the height of the
narration, does he thus fix the king's attention. Above the brightness
of the sun - And no marvel. For what is the brightness of this created
sun, to the Sun of righteousness, the brightness of the Father's
glory?</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p14">14. In the Hebrew tongue - St. Paul was not now speaking in
Hebrew: when he was, chap. xxiii, 7, he did not add, In the Hebrew
tongue. Christ used this tongue both on earth and from heaven.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p15">17. Delivering thee from the people - The Jews and the
Gentiles, to whom, both Jews and Gentiles, I now send thee - Paul gives
them to know, that the liberty he enjoys even in bonds, was promised to
him, as well as his preaching to the Gentiles. I, denotes the authority
of the sender. Now, the time whence his mission was dated. For his
apostleship, as well as his conversion, commenced at this moment.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p16">18. To open - He opens them, who sends Paul; and he does it
by Paul who is sent; their eyes - Both of the Jews and Gentiles: that
they may turn - Through the power of the Almighty, from the spiritual
darkness wherein they were involved, to the light of Divine knowledge
and holiness, and from the power of Satan, who now holds them in sin,
guilt, and misery, to the love and happy service of God: that they may
receive through faith - (He seems to place the same blessings in a
fuller light,) pardon, holiness, and glory.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p17">19. From that time - Having received power to obey, I was
not disobedient - I did obey, I used that power, <scripRef passage="Gal. i. 16" id="i.vi.xxvii-p17.1" parsed="|Gal|1|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.1.16">Gal. i, 16</scripRef>. So that even this grace whereby St. Paul was influenced was
not irresistible.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p18">20. I declared - From that hour to this, both to Jew and
Gentile, that they should repent - This repentance, we may observe, is
previous both to inward and outward holiness.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p19">21. For these things - The apostle now applies all that he
had said.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p20">22. Having obtained help from God - When all other help
failed, God sent the Roman from the castle, and so fulfilled the promise
he had made, ver. 17.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p21">24. Festus said, Paul, thou art beside thyself - To talk of
men's rising from the dead! And of a Jew's enlightening not only his own
nation, but tho polite and learned Greeks and Romans! Nay, Festus, it is
thou that art beside thyself. That strikest quite wide of the mark. And
no wonder: he saw that nature did not act in Paul; but the grace that
acted in him he did not see. And therefore he took all this ardour which
animated the apostle for a mere start of learned phrensy.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p22">25. I am not mad, most excellent Festus - The style
properly belonging to a Roman propretor. How inexpressibly beautiful is
this reply! How strong! yet how decent and respectful! Mad men seldom
call men by their names, and titles of honour. Thus also St. Paul
refutes the charge. But utter the words of truth (confirmed in the next
verse) and sobriety - The very reverse of madness. And both these
remain, even when the men of God act with the utmost vehemence.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p23">26. For the king knoweth of these things - St. Paul having
refuted Festus, pursues his purpose, returning naturally, and as it
were, step by step, from Festus to Agrippa. To whom I speak with freedom
- This freedom was probably one circumstance which Festus accounted
madness.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p24">27. King Agrippa, believest thou the prophets? - He that
believes these, believes Paul, yea, and Christ. The apostle now comes
close to his heart. What did Agrippa feel when he heard this? I know
that thou believest! - Here Paul lays so fast hold on the king that he
can scarce make any resistance.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p25">28. Then Agrippa said unto Paul, Almost thou persuadest me
to be a Christian! - See here, Festus altogether a heathen, Paul
alogether a Christian, Agrippa halting between both. Poor Agrippa! But
almost persuaded! So near the mark, and yet fall short! Another step,
and thou art within the vail. Reader, stop not with Agrippa; but go on
with Paul.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p26">29. I would to God - Agrippa had spoke of being a
Christian, as a thing wholly in his own power. Paul gently corrects this
mistake; intimating, it is the gift and the work of God; that all that
hear me - It was modesty in St. Paul, not to apply directly to them all;
yet he looks upon them and observes them; were such as I am - Christians
indeed; full of righteousness, peace, and joy in the Holy Ghost. He
speaks from a full sense of his own happiness, and an overflowing love
to all.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p27">30. And as he said this, the king rose up - An unspeakably
precious moment to Agrippa. Whether he duly improved it or no, we shall
see in that day.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxvii-p28">31. This man doth nothing worthy of death, or of bonds -
They speak of his whole life, not of one action only. And could ye learn
nothing more than this from that discourse? A favourable judgment of
such a preacher, is not all that God requires.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="12.43%" prev="i.vi.xxvii" next="i.vi.xxix" id="i.vi.xxviii">
<h3 id="i.vi.xxviii-p0.1">XXVII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XXVII" id="i.vi.xxviii-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.27" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p1">1. As soon as it was determined to sail - As being a
shorter and less expensive passage to Rome.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p2">2. Adramyttium - was a sea port of Mysia. Aristarchus and
Luke went with Paul by choice, not being ashamed of his bonds.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p3">3. Julius treating Paul courteously - Perhaps he had heard
him make his defense.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p4">4. We sailed under Cyprus - Leaving it on the left
hand.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p5">7. Cnidus - was a cape and city of Caria.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p6">8. The Fair Havens still retain the name. But the city of
Lasea is now utterly lost, together with many more of the hundred cities
for which Crete was once so renowned.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p7">9. The fast, or day of atonement, was kept on the tenth of
Tisri, that is, the</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p8">25th of September. This was to them an ill time of sailing;
not only because winter was approaching, but also because of the sudden
storms, which are still common in the Mediterranean at that time of the
year. Paul exhorted them - Not to leave Crete. Even in external things,
faith exerts itself with the greatest presence of mind, and readiness of
advice.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p9">10. Saying to them - To the centurion and other
officers.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p10">11. The centurion regarded the master - And indeed it is a
general rule, believe an artificer in his own art. Yet when there is the
greatest need, a real Christian will often advise even better than
him.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p11">12. Which is a haven - Having a double opening, one to the
southwest, the other to the northwest.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p12">14. There arose against it - The south wind; a tempestuous
wind, called in those parts Euroclydon. This was a kind of hurricane,
not carrying them any one way, but tossing them backward and forward.
These furious winds are now called levanters, and blow in all directions
from the northeast to the southeast.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p13">16. We were hardly able to get masters of the boat - To
prevent its being staved.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p14">18. They lightened the ship - Casting the heavy goods into
the sea.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p15">19. We cast out the tackling of the ship - Cutting away
even those masts that were not absolutely necessary.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p16">20. Neither sun nor stars appeared for many days - Which
they could the less spare, before the compass was found out.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p17">21. This loss - Which is before your eyes.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p18">23. The God whose I am, and whom I serve - How short a
compendium of religion! Yet how full! Comprehending both faith, hope,
and love.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p19">24. God hath given - Paul had prayed for them. And God gave
him their lives; perhaps their souls also. And the centurion, subserving
the providence of God, gave to Paul the lives of the prisoners. How
wonderfully does his providence reign in the most contingent things! And
rather will many bad men be preserved with a few good, (so it frequently
happens,) than one good man perish with many bad. So it was in this
ship: so it is in the world. Thee - At such a time as this, there was
not the same danger, which might otherwise have been, of St. Paul's
seeming to speak out of vanity, what he really spoke out of necessity.
All the souls - Not only all the prisoners, as Julius afterward did,
ver. 43; ask for souls, they shall be given thee: yea, more than thou
hopest for, that sail with thee - So that Paul, in the sight of God, was
the master and pilot of the ship.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p20">27. The fourteenth night - Since they left Crete, ver. 18,
19. In the Adriatic sea - So the ancients called all that part of the
Mediterranean, which lay south of Italy.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p21">30. The sailors were attempting to flee out of the ship -
Supposing the boat would go more safely over the shallows.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p22">31. Unless these mariners abide in the ship - Without them
ye know not how to manage her, ye cannot be saved - He does not say we.
That they would not have regarded. The soldiers were not careful for the
lives of the prisoners: nor was Paul careful for his own. We may learn
hence, to use the most proper means for security and success, even while
we depend on Divine Providence, and wait for the accomplishment of God's
own promise. He never designed any promise should encourage rational
creatures to act in an irrational manner; or to remain inactive, when he
has given them natural capacities of doing something, at least, for
their own benefit. To expect the accomplishment of any promise, without
exerting these, is at best vain and dangerous presumption, if all
pretense of relying upon it be not profane hypocrisy.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p23">33. Ye continue fasting, having taken nothing - No regular
meal, through a deep sense of their extreme danger. Let us not wonder
then, if men who have a deep sense of their extreme danger of
everlasting death, for a time forget even to eat their bread, or to
attend to their worldly affairs. Much less let us censure that as
madness, which may be the beginning of true wisdom.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p24">34. This is for your preservation - That ye may be the
better able to swim to shore.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p25">36. Then they were all encouraged - By his example, as well
as words.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p26">38. Casting out the wheat - So firmly did they now depend
on what St. Paul had said.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p27">39. They did not know the land - Which they saw near them:
having a level shore.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p28">40. Loosing the rudder bands - Their ships had frequently
two rudders, one on each side. were fastened while they let the ship
drive; but were now loosened, when they had need of them to steer her
into the creek.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p29">41. A place where two seas met - Probably by reason of a
sand bank running parallel with the shore.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p30">42. The counsel - Cruel, unjust, ungrateful.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxviii-p31">44. They all escaped safe to land - And some of them
doubtless received the apostle as a teacher sent from God. These would
find their deliverance from the fury of the sea, but an earnest of an
infinitely greater deliverance, and are long ere this lodged with him in
a more peaceful harbour than Malta, or than the earth could afford.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVIII" progress="12.53%" prev="i.vi.xxviii" next="i.vii" id="i.vi.xxix">
<h3 id="i.vi.xxix-p0.1">XXVIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Acts XXVIII" id="i.vi.xxix-p0.2" parsed="|Acts|28|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.28" /> 

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p1">1. Melita or Malta, is about twelve miles broad, twenty
long, and sixty distant from Sicily to the south. It yields abundance of
honey, (whence its name was taken,) with much cotton, and is very
fruitful, though it has only three feet depth of earth above the solid
rock. The Emperor Charles the Fifth gave it, in 1530, to the knights of
Rhodes, driven out of Rhodes by the Turks. They are a thousand in
number, of whom five hundred always reside on the island.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p2">2. And the barbarians - So the Roman and Greeks termed all
nations but their own. But surely the generosity shown by these
uncultivated inhabitants of Malta, was far more valuable than all the
varnish which the politest education could give, where it taught not
humanity and compassion.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p3">4. And when the barbarians saw - they said - Seeing also
his chains, Doubtless this man is a murderer - Such rarely go unpunished
even in this life; whom vengeance hath not suffered to live - They look
upon him as a dead man already. It is with pleasure that we trace among
these barbarians the force of conscience, and the belief of a particular
providence: which some people of more learning have stupidly thought it
philosophy to despise. But they erred in imagining, that calamities must
always be interpreted as judgments. Let us guard against this, lest,
like them, we condemn not only the innocent, but the excellent of the
earth.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p4">5. Having shaken off the venomous animal, he suffered no
harm - The words of an eminent modern historian are, "No venomous kind
of serpent now breeds in Malta, neither hurts if it be brought thither
from another place. Children are seen there handling and playing even
with scorpions; I have seen one eating them." If this be so, it seems to
be fixed by the wisdom of God, as an eternal memorial of what he once
wrought there.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p5">6. They changed their minds, and said he was a God - Such
is the stability of human reason! A little before he was a murderer; and
presently he is a God: (just as the people of Lystra; one hour
sacrificing, and the next stoning:) nay, but there is a medium. He is
neither a murderer nor a God, but a man of God. But natural men never
run into greater mistakes, than in judging of the children of God.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p6">7. The chief man of the island - In wealth if not in power
also. Three days - The first three days of our stay on the island.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p7">11. Whose sign was - It was the custom of the ancients to
have images on the head of their ships, from which they took their
names. Castor and Pollux - Two heathen gods who were thought favourable
to mariners.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p8">15. The brethren -- that is, the Christians, came out thence
to meet us - It is remarkable that there is no certain account by whom
Christianity was planted at Rome. Probably some inhabitants of that city
were at Jerusalem on the day of pentecost, chap. ii, 10; and being then
converted themselves, carried the Gospel thither at their return.
Appii-Forum was a town fifty-one miles from Rome; the Three Taverns
about thirty. He took courage - He saw Christ was at Rome also, and now
forgot all the troubles of his journey.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p9">16. With the soldier - To whom he was chained, as the Roman
custom was.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p10">17. And after three days - Given to rest and prayer, Paul
called the chief of the Jews together - He always sought the Jews first;
but being now bound, he could not so conveniently go round to them.
Though I have done nothing - Seeing him chained, they might have
suspected he had. Therefore he first obviates this suspicion.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p11">19. When the Jews opposed it - He speaks tenderly of them,
not mentioning their repeated attempts to murder him. Not that I had any
thing to accuse my nation of - Not that I had any design to accuse
others, but merely to defend myself.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p12">20. The hope of Israel - What Israel hopes for, namely, the
Messiah and the resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p13">21. We have neither received letters concerning thee -
There must have been a peculiar providence in this, nor has any of the
brethren -- the Jews, related - Professedly, in a set discourse, or spoke
- Occasionally, in conversation, any evil of thee - How must the bridle
then have been in their mouth!</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p14">22. This sect we know is everywhere spoken against - This
is no proof at all of a bad cause, but a very probable mark of a good
one.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p15">23. To whom he expounded, testifying the kingdom of God,
and persuading them concerning Jesus - These were his two grand
topics,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.xxix-p16">1. That the kingdom of the Messiah was of a
spiritual, not temporal nature:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vi.xxix-p17">2. That Jesus of Nazareth was the very person
foretold, as the Lord of that kingdom. On this head he had as much need
to persuade as to convince, their will making as strong a resistance as
their understanding.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p18">24. And some believed the things that were spoken - With
the heart, as well as understanding.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p19">25. Well spake the Holy Ghost to your fathers - Which is
equally applicable to you.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p20">26. Hearing ye shall hear - That is, ye shall most surely
hear, and shall not understand - The words manifestly denote a judicial
blindness, consequent upon a wilful and obstinate resistance of the
truth. First they would not, afterward they could not, believe. <scripRef passage="Isaiah vi. 9" id="i.vi.xxix-p20.1" parsed="|Isa|6|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.6.9">Isaiah vi, 9</scripRef>, &amp;c.; <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 14" id="i.vi.xxix-p20.2" parsed="|Matt|13|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.14">Matt. xiii, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John xii. 40" id="i.vi.xxix-p20.3" parsed="|John|12|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.40">John xii, 40</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p21">28. The salvation of God is sent to the Gentiles - Namely,
from this time. Before this no apostle had been at Rome. St. Paul was
the first.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p22">30. And Paul continued two whole years - After which this
book was written, long before St. Paul's death, and was undoubtedly
published with his approbation by St. Luke, who continued with him to
the last, <scripRef passage="2 Tim. iv. 11" id="i.vi.xxix-p22.1" parsed="|2Tim|4|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.4.11">2 Tim. iv, 11</scripRef>. And received all that came to him - Whether they were Jews
or Gentiles. These two years completed twenty-five years after our
saviour's passion. Such progress had the Gospel made by that time, in
the parts of the world which lay west of Jerusalem, by the ministry of
St. Paul among the Gentiles. How far eastward the other apostles had
carried it in the same time, history does not inform us.</p>

<p id="i.vi.xxix-p23">31. No man forbidding him - Such was the victory of the
word of God. While Paul was preaching at Rome, the Gospel shone with its
highest lustre. Here therefore the Acts of the Apostles end; and end
with great advantage. Otherwise St. Luke could easily have continued his
narrative to the apostle's death.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE ROMANS" progress="12.64%" prev="i.vi.xxix" next="i.vii.i" id="i.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rom" id="i.vii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.vii-p0.2">NOTES ON ST PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE ROMANS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Romans" progress="12.64%" prev="i.vii" next="i.vii.ii" id="i.vii.i">

<p id="i.vii.i-p1">MANY of the writings of the New Testament are written in
the form of epistles. Such are not only those of St. Paul, James, Peter,
Jude, but also both the treatises of St. Luke, and all the writings of
St. John. Nay, we have seven epistles herein which the Lord Jesus
himself sent by the hand of John to the seven churches; yea, the whole
Rev. is no other than an epistle from Him. Concerning the epistles of
St. Paul, we may observe, he writes in a very different manner to those
churches which he had planted himself, and to those who had not seen his
face in the flesh. In his letters to the former, a loving or sharp
familiarity appears, as their behaviour was more or less suitable to the
gospel. To the latter, he proposes the pure, unmixed gospel, in a more
general and abstract manner. As to the time wherein he wrote his
epistles, it is probable he wrote about the year of Christ, according to
the common reckoning, 48 From Corinth, The Epistle to the Thessalonians.
49 From Phrygia, To the <scripRef passage="Galatians. 52" id="i.vii.i-p1.1" parsed="|Gal|52|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.52">Galatians. 52</scripRef> From Ephesus, The First to the
Corinthians. From Troas, The First Epistle to Timothy. From
Macedonia,The Second to the Corinthians, and that to Titus. From
Corinth, To the <scripRef passage="Romans. 57" id="i.vii.i-p1.2" parsed="|Rom|57|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.57">Romans. 57</scripRef> From Rome, To the Philippians, to Philemon,
the Ephesians, and <scripRef passage="Colossians. 53" id="i.vii.i-p1.3" parsed="|Col|53|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.53">Colossians. 53</scripRef> From Italy, To the <scripRef passage="Hebrews. 66" id="i.vii.i-p1.4" parsed="|Heb|66|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.66">Hebrews. 66</scripRef> From
Rome, The Second to Timothy. As to the general epistles, it seems, St.
James wrote a little before his death, which was A. D. 63. St. Peter,
who was martyred in the year 67, wrote his latter epistle a little
before his death, and not long after his former. St. Jude wrote after
him, when the mystery of iniquity was gaining ground swiftly. St. John
is believed to have wrote all his epistles a little before his
departure. The Revelation he wrote A. D. 96. That St. Paul wrote this
epistle from Corinth we may learn from his commending to the Roman
Phebe, a servant of the church of Cenchrea, chap. xvi, 1, a port of
Corinth; and from his mentioning the salutations of Caius and Erastus,
chap. xvi, 23, who were both Corinthians. Those to whom he wrote seem to
have been chiefly foreigners, both Jews and gentiles, whom business drew
from other provinces; as appears, both by his writing in Greek, and by
his salutations of several former acquaintance. His chief design herein
is to show,</p>

<p id="i.vii.i-p2">1, That neither the gentiles by the law of nature, nor the
Jews by the law of Moses, could obtain justification before God; and
that therefore it was necessary for both to seek it from the free mercy
of God by faith.</p>

<p id="i.vii.i-p3">2, That God has an absolute right to show mercy on what
terms he pleases, and to withhold it from those who will not accept it
on his own terms. This Epistle consists of five parts: -</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.vii.i-p4">I. The introduction, C.i.1-15</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.vii.i-p5">II. The proposition briefly proved,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p6">1. Concerning faith and justification,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p7">2. Concerning salvation,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p8">3. Concerning the equality of believers, Jews
or gentiles, 16-17 To these three parts, whereof The first is treated
of, C.i.18-iv. The second, C.v-viii. The third, C.ix.-xi not only the
treatise itself, but also the exhortation, answers in the same
order.</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.vii.i-p9">III. The treatise,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p10">1. Concerning justification, which is, (1.)
Not by works, for C.i.18 The gentiles, C.ii.1-10  The Jews, and 11-29
Both together are under sin, C.iii.1-20 (2.) But by faith, 21-31 as
appears by the example of Abraham, and the testimony of David,
C.iv.1-25</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p11">2. Concerning salvation, C.v.-viii.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p12">3. Concerning the equal privileges of Jewish
and gentile believers, C.ix.-xi.</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.vii.i-p13">IV. The exhortation, C.xii.1-2</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p14">1. Concerning faith and its fruits, love and
practical holiness, 3-21 C.xiii.1-10</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p15">2. Concerning salvation, 11-14</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p16">3. Of the conjunction of Jews and gentiles,.
C.xiv.1-xv.13</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.vii.i-p17">V. The conclusion, 14-xvi.25 To express the
design and contents of this epistle a little more at large: The apostle
labours throughout to fix in those to whom he writes a deep sense of the
excellency of the gospel, and to engage them to act suitably to it. For
this purpose, after a general salutation, chap. i, 1-7, and profession
of his affection for them, chap. i, 8-15, he declares he shall not be
ashamed openly to maintain the gospel at Rome, seeing it is the powerful
instrument of salvation, both to Jews and gentiles, by means of faith,
chap. i, 16, 17. And, in order to demonstrate this, he shows,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p18">1. That the world greatly needed such a
dispensation, the gentiles being in a most abandoned state, chap. i,
18-32, and the Jews, though condemning others, being themselves no
better, chap. ii, 1- 29; as, not withstanding some cavils, which he
obviates, chap. iii, 1-8, their own scriptures testify, chap. iii, 9-19.
So that all were under a necessity of seeking justification by this
method, chap. iii, 20-31.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p19">2. That Abraham and David themselves sought
justification by faith, and not by works, chap. iv, 1-25.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p20">3. That all who believe are brought into so
happy a state, as turns the greatest afflictions into a matter of joy,
chap. v, 1-11.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p21">4. That the evils brought on mankind by Adam
are abundantly recompensed to all that believe in Christ, chap. v,
12-21.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p22">5. That, far from dissolving the obligations
to practical holiness, the gospel increases them by peculiar
obligations, chap. vi, 1-23. In order to convince them of these things
the more deeply, and to remove their fondness for the Mosaic law, now
they were married to Christ by faith in him, chap. vii, 1-6, he shows
how unable the motives of the law were to produce that holiness which
believers obtain by a living faith in the gospel, chap. vii, 7-25, viii,
1, 2, and then gives a more particular view of those things which
rendered the gospel effectual to this great end, chap. viii, 3-39. That
even the gentiles, if they believed, should have a share in these
blessings, and that the Jews, if they believed not, should be excluded
from them, being a point of great importance, the apostle bestows the
ninth, tenth, and eleventh chapters in settling it. He begins the ninth
chapter by expressing his tender love and high esteem for the Jewish
nation, chap. ix, 1-5, and then shows,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.i-p23">1. That God's rejecting great part of the
seed of Abraham, yea, and of Isaac too, was undeniable fact, chap. ix,
6-13.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.i-p24">2. That God had not chosen them to such
peculiar privileges for any kind of goodness either in them or their
fathers, chap. ix, 14- 24.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.i-p25">3. That his accepting the gentiles, and
rejecting many of the Jews, had been foretold both by Hosea and Isaiah,
chap. ix, 25-33.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.i-p26">4. That God had offered salvation to Jews and
gentiles on the same terms, though the Jews had rejected it, chap. x,
1-21.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.i-p27">5. That though the rejection of Israel for
their obstinacy was general, yet it was not total; there being still a
remnant among them who did embrace the gospel, chap. xi, 1-10.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p28">6. That the rejection of the rest was not
final, but in the end all Israel should be saved, chap. xi, 11-31.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.vii.i-p29">7. That, meantime, even their obstinacy and
rejection served to display the unsearchable wisdom and love of God,
chap. xi, 32- 36. The rest of the epistle contains practical
instructions and exhortations. He particularly urges,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.i-p30">1. An entire consecration of themselves to
God, and a care to glorify Him by a faithful improvement of their
several talents, chap. vii, 1-11.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.i-p31">2. Devotion, patience, hospitality, mutual
sympathy, humility, peace, and meekness, chap. vii, 12-21.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.i-p32">3. Obedience to magistrates, justice in all
its branches, love the fulfilling of the law, and universal holiness,
chap. viii, 1-14.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.i-p33">4. Mutual candour between those who differed
in judgment, touching the observance of the Mosaic law, chap. xiv, 1-23,
xv, 1- 17; in enforcing which he is led to mention the extent of his own
labours, and his purpose of visiting the Romans; in the mean time
recommending himself to their prayers, chap. xv, 18-33. And, after many
salutations, chap. xvi, 1-16, and a caution against those who caused
divisions, he concludes with a suitable blessing and doxology, chap.
xvi, 17-27.</p>
<h2 id="i.vii.i-p33.1">ROMANS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="12.78%" prev="i.vii.i" next="i.vii.iii" id="i.vii.ii">
<h3 id="i.vii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans I" id="i.vii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.1" /> 

<p id="i.vii.ii-p1">1. Paul, a servant of Jesus Christ -To this introduction
the conclusion answers, chap. xv, 15, &amp;c. Called to be an apostle -
And made an apostle by that calling. While God calls, he makes what he
calls. As the Judaizing teachers disputed his claim to the apostolical
office, it is with great propriety that he asserts it in the very
entrance of an epistle wherein their principles are entirely overthrown.
And various other proper and important thoughts are suggested in this
short introduction; particularly the prophecies concerning the gospel,
the descent of Jesus from David, the great doctrines of his Godhead and
resurrection, the sending the gospel to the gentiles, the privileges of
Christians, and the obedience and holiness to which they were obliged in
virtue of their profession. Separated - By God, not only from the bulk
of other men, from other Jews, from other disciples, but even from other
Christian teachers, to be a peculiar instrument of God in spreading the
gospel.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p2">2. Which he promised before - Of old time, frequently,
solemnly. And the promise and accomplishment confirm each other. <scripRef passage="Deut. xviii. 18" id="i.vii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Deut|18|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.18.18">Deut. xviii, 18</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Isa. ix. 6, 7" id="i.vii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Isa|9|6|9|7" osisRef="Bible:Isa.9.6-Isa.9.7">Isa. ix, 6, 7</scripRef>; Chapter liii; lxi; <scripRef passage="Jer. xxiii. 5" id="i.vii.ii-p2.3" parsed="|Jer|23|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.23.5">Jer. xxiii, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p3">3. Who was of the seed of David according to the flesh -
That is, with regard to his human nature. Both the natures of our
saviour are here mentioned; but the human is mentioned first, because
the divine was not manifested in its full evidence till after his
resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p4">4. But powerfully declared to be the Son of God, according
to the Spirit of Holiness - That is, according to his divine nature. By
the resurrection from the dead - For this is both the fountain and the
object of our faith; and the preaching of the apostles was the
consequence of Christ's resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p5">5. By whom we have received - I and the other apostles.
Grace and apostleship - The favour to be an apostle, and qualifications
for it. For obedience to the faith in all nations - That is, that all
nations may embrace the faith of Christ. For his name - For his sake;
out of regard to him.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p6">6. Among whom - The nations brought to the obedience of
faith. Are ye also - But St. Paul gives them no preeminence above
others.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p7">7. To all that are in Rome - Most of these were heathens by
birth, ver. 13, though with Jews mixed among them. They were scattered
up and down in that large city, and not yet reduced into the form of a
church. Only some had begun to meet in the house of Aquila and
Priscilla. Beloved of God - And from his free love, not from any merit
of yours, called by his word and his Spirit to believe in him, and now
through faith holy as he is holy. Grace - The peculiar favour of God.
And peace - All manner of blessings, temporal, spiritual, and eternal.
This is both a Christian salutation and an apostolic benediction. From
God our Father, and the Lord Jesus Christ - This is the usual way
wherein the apostles speak, "God the Father," "God our Father." Nor do
they often, in speaking of him, use the word Lord, as it implies the
proper name of God, Jehovah. In the Old Testament, indeed, the holy men
generally said, "The Lord our God;" for they were then, as it were,
servants; whereas now they are sons: and sons so well know their father,
that they need not frequently mention his proper name. It is one and the
same peace, and one and the same grace, which is from God and from Jesus
Christ. Our trust and prayer fix on God, as he is the Father of Christ;
and on Christ, as he presents us to the Father.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p8">8. I thank - In the very entrance of this one epistle are
the traces of all spiritual affections; but of thankfulness above all,
with the expression of which almost all St. Paul's epistles begin. He
here particularly thanks God, that what otherwise himself should have
done, was done at Rome already. My God - This very word expresses faith,
hope, love, and consequently all true religion. Through Jesus Christ -
The gifts of God all pass through Christ to us; and all our petitions
and thanksgivings pass through Christ to God. That your faith is spoken
of - In this kind of congratulations St. Paul describes either the whole
of Christianity, as <scripRef passage="Colossians i. 3" id="i.vii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Col|1|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.1.3">Colossians i, 3</scripRef>, &amp;c.; or some part of it, as <scripRef passage="1 Cor. i. 5" id="i.vii.ii-p8.2" parsed="|1Cor|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.1.5">1 Cor. i, 5</scripRef>. Accordingly here he mentions the faith of the Romans,
suitably to his design, ver. 12, 17. Through the whole world - This
joyful news spreading everywhere, that there were Christians also in the
imperial city. And the goodness and wisdom of God established faith in
the chief cities; in Jerusalem and Rome particularly; that from thence
it might be diffused to all nations.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p9">9. God, whom I serve - As an apostle. In my spirit - Not
only with my body, but with my inmost soul. In the gospel - By preaching
it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p10">10. Always - In all my solemn addresses to God. If by any
means now at length - This accumulation of particles declares the
strength of his desire.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p11">11. That I may impart to you - Face to face, by laying on
of hands, prayer, preaching the gospel, private conversation. Some
spiritual gift - With such gifts the Corinthians, who had enjoyed the
presence of St. Paul, abounded, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. i. 7; xii. 1; xiv. 1" id="i.vii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|1Cor|1|7|0|0;|1Cor|12|1|0|0;|1Cor|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.1.7 Bible:1Cor.12.1 Bible:1Cor.14.1">1 Cor. i, 7; xii, 1;
xiv, 1</scripRef>. So did the Galatians likewise, <scripRef passage="Gal. iii. 5" id="i.vii.ii-p11.2" parsed="|Gal|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.3.5">Gal. iii, 5</scripRef>; and, indeed, all those churches which had had the presence
of any of the apostles had peculiar advantages in this kind, from the
laying on of their hands, <scripRef passage="Acts xix. 6; viii. 17" id="i.vii.ii-p11.3" parsed="|Acts|19|6|0|0;|Acts|8|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.19.6 Bible:Acts.8.17">Acts xix, 6; viii, 17</scripRef>, &amp;c., <scripRef passage="2 Tim. i. 6" id="i.vii.ii-p11.4" parsed="|2Tim|1|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.1.6">2 Tim. i, 6</scripRef>. But as yet the Roman were greatly inferior to them in this
respect; for which reason the apostle, in the twelfth chapter also, says
little, if any thing, of their spiritual gifts. He therefore desires to
impart some, that they might be established; for by these was the
testimony of Christ confirmed among them. That St. Peter had no more
been at Rome than St. Paul, at the time when this epistle was written,
appears from the general tenor thereof, and from this place in
particular: for, otherwise, what St. Paul wishes to impart to the Roman
would have been imparted already by St. Peter.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p12">12. That is, I long to be comforted by the mutual faith
both of you and me - He not only associates the Roman with, but even
prefers them before, himself. How different is this style of the apostle
from that of the modern court of Rome!</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p13">13. Brethren - A frequent, holy, simple, sweet, and yet
grand, appellation. The apostles but rarely address persons by their
names; 'O ye Corinthians," "O Timotheus." St. Paul generally uses this
appellation, " Brethren;" sometimes in exhortation, " My beloved," or, "
My beloved brethren;" St. James, "Brethren," "My brethren," My beloved
brethren;" St. Peter and Jude always, " Beloved;" St. John frequently, "
Beloved;" once, " Brethren;" oftener than once, My little children."
Though I have been hindered hitherto - Either by business, see chap. xv,
22; or persecution, <scripRef passage="1 Thess. ii. 2" id="i.vii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|1Thess|2|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.2.2">1 Thess. ii,
2</scripRef>; or the Spirit, <scripRef passage="Acts xvi. 7" id="i.vii.ii-p13.2" parsed="|Acts|16|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.16.7">Acts xvi,
7</scripRef>. That I might have some fruit - Of my ministerial labours.
Even as I have already had from the many churches I have planted and
watered among the other gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p14">14. To the Greeks and the barbarians - He includes the
Roman under the Greeks; so that this division comprises all nations.
Both to the wise, and the unwise - For there were unwise even among the
Greeks, and wise even among the barbarians. I am a debtor to all - I am
bound by my divine mission to preach the gospel to them.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p15">16. For I am not ashamed of the gospel - To the world,
indeed, it is folly and weakness, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. i. 18" id="i.vii.ii-p15.1" parsed="|1Cor|1|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.1.18">1
Cor. i, 18</scripRef>; therefore, in the judgment of the world, he ought to be
ashamed of it; especially at Rome, the head and theatre of the world.
But Paul is not ashamed, knowing it is the power of God unto salvation
to every one that believeth - The great and gloriously powerful means of
saving all who accept salvation in God's own way. As St. Paul comprises
the sum of the gospel in this epistle, so he does the sum of the epistle
in this and the following verse. Both to the Jew, and to the gentile -
There is a noble frankness, as well as a comprehensive sense, in these
words, by which he, on the one hand, shows the Jews their absolute need
of the gospel; and, on the other, tells the politest and greatest nation
in the world both that their salvation depended on receiving it, and
that the first offers of it were in every place to be made to the
despised Jews.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p16">17. The righteousness of God - This expression sometimes
means God's eternal, essential righteousness, which includes both
justice and mercy, and is eminently shown in condemning sin, and yet
justifying the sinner. Sometimes it means that righteousness by which a
man, through the gift of God, is made and is righteous; and that, both
by receiving Christ through faith, and by a conformity to the essential
righteousness of God. St. Paul, when treating of justification, means
hereby the righteousness of faith; therefore called the righteousness of
God, because God found out and prepared, reveals and gives, approves and
crowns it. In this verse the expression means, the whole benefit of God
through Christ for the salvation of a sinner. Is revealed - Mention is
made here, and ver. 18, of a twofold Revelation, - of wrath and of
righteousness: the former, little known to nature, is revealed by the
law; the latter, wholly unknown to nature, by the gospel. That goes
before, and prepares the way; this follows. Each, the apostle says, is
revealed at the present time, in opposition to the times of ignorance.
From faith to faith - By a gradual series of still clearer and clearer
promises. As it is written - St. Paul had just laid down three
propositions:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.ii-p17">1. Righteousness is by faith, ver. xvii,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.ii-p18">2. Salvation is by righteousness, ver.
xvi,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.ii-p19">3. Both to the Jews and to the gentiles, ver.
16. Now all these are confirmed by that single sentence, The just shall
live by faith - Which was primarily spoken of those who preserved their
lives, when the Chaldeans besieged Jerusalem, by believing the
declarations of God, and acting according to them. Here it means, He
shall obtain the favour of God, and continue therein by believing. <scripRef passage="Hab. ii. 4" id="i.vii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Hab|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hab.2.4">Hab. ii, 4</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p20">18. For - There is no other way of obtaining life and
salvation. Having laid down his proposition, the apostle now enters upon
the proof of it. His first argument is, The law condemns all men, as
being under sin. None therefore is justified by the works of the law.
This is treated of chap. iii, 20. And hence he infers, Therefore
justification is by faith. The wrath of God is revealed - Not only by
frequent and signal interpositions of divine providence, but likewise in
the sacred oracles, and by us, his messengers. From heaven - This speaks
the majesty of Him whose wrath is revealed, his all-seeing eye, and the
extent of his wrath: whatever is under heaven is under the effects of
his wrath, believers in Christ excepted. Against all ungodliness and
unrighteousness - These two are treated of, ver. 23, &amp;c. Of men - He
is speaking here of the gentiles, and chiefly the wisest of them. Who
detain the truth - For it struggles against their wickedness. In
unrighteousness - The word here includes ungodliness also.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p21">19. For what is to be known of God - Those great principles
which are indispensably necessary to be known. Is manifest in them; for
God hath showed it to them - By the light which enlightens every man
that cometh into the world.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p22">20. For those things of him which are invisible, are seen -
By the eye of the mind. Being understood - They are seen by them, and
them only, who use their understanding</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p23">21. Because, knowing God - For the wiser heathens did know
that there was one supreme God; yet from low and base considerations
they conformed to the idolatry of the vulgar. They did not glorify him
as God, neither were thankful - They neither thanked him for his
benefits, nor glorified him for his divine perfection. But became vain -
Like the idols they worshipped. In their reasonings - Various,
uncertain, foolish. What a terrible instance have we of this in the
writings of Lucretius! What vain reasonings, and how dark a heart,
amidst so pompous professions of wisdom!</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p24">23. And changed - With the utmost folly. Here are three
degrees of ungodliness and of punishment: the first is described, ver.
21- 24; the second, ver. 25-27; the third, in ver. 28, and following
verses. The punishment in each case is expressed by God gave them up. If
a man will not worship God as God, he is so left to himself that he
throws away his very manhood. Reptiles - Or creeping things; as beetles,
and various kinds of serpents.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p25">24. Wherefore - One punishment of sin is from the very
nature of it, as ver. 27; another, as here, is from vindictive justice.
Uncleanness - Ungodliness and uncleanness are frequently joined, <scripRef passage="1 Thess. iv. 5" id="i.vii.ii-p25.1" parsed="|1Thess|4|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.4.5">1 Thess. iv, 5</scripRef> as are the knowledge of God and purity. God gave them up -
By withdrawing his restraining grace.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p26">25. Who changed the truth - The true worship of God. Into a
lie - False, abominable idolatries. And worshipped - Inwardly. And
served - Outwardly.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p27">26. Therefore God gave them up to vile affections - To
which the heathen Roman were then abandoned to the last degree; and none
more than the emperors themselves.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p28">27. Receiving the just recompense of their error - Their
idolatry being punished with that unnatural lust, which was as horrible
a dishonour to the body, as their idolatry was to God.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p29">28. God gave them up to an undiscerning mind - Treated of,
ver. 32. To do things not expedient - Even the vilest abominations,
treated of ver. 29-31.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p30">29. Filled with all injustice - This stands in the first
place; unmercifulness, in the last. Fornication - Includes here every
species of uncleanness. Maliciousness - The Greek word properly implies
a temper which delights in hurting another, even without any advantage
to itself.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p31">30. Whisperers - Such as secretly defame others. Backbiters
- Such as speak against others behind their back. Haters of God - That
is, rebels against him, deniers of his providence, or accusers of his
justice in their adversities; yea, having an inward heart- enmity to his
justice and holiness. Inventors of evil things - Of new pleasures, new
ways of gain, new arts of hurting, particularly in war.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p32">31. Covenant-breakers - It is well known, the Romans, as a
nation, from the very beginning of their commonwealth, never made any
scruple of vacating altogether the most solemn engagement, if they did
not like it, though made by their supreme magistrate, in the name of the
whole people. They only gave up the general who had made it, and then
supposed themselves to be at full liberty. Without natural affection -
The custom of exposing their own new - born children to perish by cold,
hunger, or wild beasts, which so generally prevailed in the heathen
world, particularly among the Greeks and Romans, was an amazing instance
of this; as is also that of killing their aged and helpless parents, now
common among the American heathens.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ii-p33">32. Not only do the same, but have pleasure in those that
practice them - This is the highest degree of wickedness. A man may be
hurried by his passions to do the thing he hates; but he that has
pleasure in those that do evil, loves wickedness for wickedness' sake.
And hereby he encourages them in sin, and heaps the guilt of others upon
his own head.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="13.05%" prev="i.vii.ii" next="i.vii.iv" id="i.vii.iii">
<h3 id="i.vii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans II" id="i.vii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.2" /> 

<p id="i.vii.iii-p1">1. Therefore - The apostle now makes a transition from the
gentiles to the Jews, till, at ver. 6, he comprises both. Thou art
inexcusable - Seeing knowledge without practice only increases guilt. O
man - Having before spoken of the gentile in the third person, he
addresses the Jew in the second person. But he calls him by a common
appellation, as not acknowledging him to be a Jew. See verses 17, 28.
Whosoever thou art that Judgest - Censurest, condemnest. For in that
thou Judgest the other - The heathen. Thou condemnest thyself; for thou
doest the same things - In effect; in many instances.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p2">2. For we know - Without thy teaching That the judgment of
God - Not thine, who exceptest thyself from its sentence. Is according
to truth - Is just, making no exception, ver. 5, 6, 11; and reaches the
heart as well as the life, ver. 16.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p3">3. That thou shalt escape - Rather than the gentile.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p4">4. Or despisest thou - Dost thou go farther still, - from
hoping to escape his wrath, to the abuse of his love?. The riches - The
abundance. Of his goodness, forbearance, and longsuffering - Seeing thou
both hast sinned, dost sin, and wilt sin. All these are afterwards
comprised in the single word goodness. Leadeth thee - That is, is
designed of God to lead or encourage thee to it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p5">5. Treasurest up wrath - Although thou thinkest thou art
treasuring up all good things. O what a treasure may a man lay up either
way, in this short day of life! To thyself - Not to him whom thou
Judgest. In the day of wrath, and Revelation, and righteous judgment of
God - Just opposite to "the goodness and forbearance and longsuffering"
of God. When God shall be revealed, then shall also be "revealed" the
secrets of men's hearts, ver. 16. Forbearance and Revelation respect
God, and are opposed to each other; longsuffering and righteous judgment
respect the sinner; goodness and wrath are words of a more general
import.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p6">6. <scripRef passage="Prov. xxiv. 12" id="i.vii.iii-p6.1" parsed="|Prov|24|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.24.12">Prov. xxiv,
12</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p7">7. To them that seek for glory - For pure love does not
exclude faith, hope, desire, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. xv. 58" id="i.vii.iii-p7.1" parsed="|1Cor|15|58|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.15.58">1 Cor.
xv, 58</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p8">8. But to them that are contentious - Like thee, O Jew, who
thus fightest against God. The character of a false Jew is disobedience,
stubbornness, impatience. Indignation and wrath, tribulation and anguish
- Alluding to Psalm lxxviii, xlix, "He cast upon them," the Egyptians.
"the fierceness of his anger, wrath, and indignation, and trouble;" and
finely intimating, that the Jews would in the day of vengeance be more
severely punished than even the Egyptians were when God made their
plagues so wonderful.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p9">9. Of the Jew first - Here we have the first express
mention of the Jews in this chapter. And it is introduced with great
propriety. Their having been trained up in the true religion, and having
had Christ and his apostles first sent to them, will place them in the
foremost rank of the criminals that obey not the truth.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p10">10. But glory - Just opposite to "wrath," from the divine
approbation. honour - Opposite to "indignation," by the divine
appointment; and peace now and forever, opposed to tribulation and
anguish.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p11">11. For there is no respect of persons with God - He will
reward every one according to his works. But this is well consistent
with his distributing advantages and opportunities of improvement,
according to his own good pleasure.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p12">12. For as many as have sinned - He speaks as of the time
past, for all time will be past at the day of judgment. Without the law
- Without having any written law. Shall also perish without the law -
Without regard had to any outward law; being condemned by the law
written in their hearts. The word also shows the agreement of the manner
of sinning, with the manner of suffering. Perish - He could not so
properly say, Shall be judged without the law.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p13">13. For not the hearers of the law are, even now, just
before God, but the doers of the law shall be justified - Finally
acquitted and rewarded a most sure and important truth, which respects
the gentiles also, though principally the Jews. St. Paul speaks of the
former, ver. 14, &amp;c.; of the latter, ver. 17, &amp;c. Here is
therefore no parenthesis; for the sixteenth verse also depends on the
fifteenth, not on the twelfth. <scripRef passage="Rom. ii. 16, 15, 12" id="i.vii.iii-p13.1" parsed="|Rom|2|16|0|0;|Rom|2|15|0|0;|Rom|2|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.2.16 Bible:Rom.2.15 Bible:Rom.2.12">Rom. ii, 16, 15, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p14">14. For when the gentiles - That is, any of them. St. Paul,
having refuted the perverse judgment of the Jews concerning the
heathens, proceeds to show the just judgment of God against them. He now
speaks directly of the heathens, in order to convince the heathens. Yet
the concession he makes to these serves more strongly to convince the
Jews. Do by nature - That is, without an outward rule; though this also,
strictly speaking, is by preventing grace. The things contained in the
law - The ten commandments being only the substance of the law of
nature. These, not having the written law, are a law unto themselves -
That is, what the law is to the Jews, they are, by the grace of God, to
themselves; namely, a rule of life.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p15">15. Who show - To themselves, to other men, and, in a
sense, to God himself. The work of the law - The substance, though not
the letter, of it. Written on their hearts - By the same hand which
wrote the commandments on the tables of stone. Their conscience - There
is none of all its faculties which the soul has less in its power than
this. Bearing witness - In a trial there are the plaintiff, the
defendant, and the witnesses. Conscience and sin itself are witnesses
against the heathens. Their thoughts sometimes excuse, sometimes
condemn, them. Among themselves - Alternately, like plaintiff and
defendant. Accusing or even defending them - The very manner of speaking
shows that they have far more room to accuse than to defend.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p16">16. In the day - That is, who show this in the day.
Everything will then be shown to be what it really is. In that day will
appear the law written in their hearts as it often does in the present
life. When God shall judge the secrets of men - On secret circumstances
depends the real quality of actions, frequently unknown to the actors
themselves, ver. 29. Men generally form their judgments, even of
themselves merely from what is apparent. According to my gospel -
According to the tenor of that gospel which is committed to my care.
Hence it appears that the gospel also is a law.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p17">17. But if thou art called a Jew - This highest point of
Jewish glorying, after a farther description of it interposed, ver.
17-20, and refuted, ver. 21-24, is itself refuted, ver. 25, &amp;c. The
description consists of twice five articles; of which the former five,
ver. 17, 18, show what he boasts of in himself; the other five, ver. 19,
20, what he glories in with respect to others. The first particular of
the former five answers to the first of the latter; the second, to the
second, and so on. And restest in the law - Dependest on it, though it
can only condemn thee. And gloriest in God - As thy God; and that, too,
to the exclusion of others.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p18">19. Blind, in darkness, ignorant, babes - These were the
titles which the Jews generally gave the gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p19">20. Having the form of knowledge and truth - That is, the
most accurate knowledge of the truth.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p20">21. Thou dost not teach thyself - He does not teach himself
who does not practice what he teaches. Dost thou steal, commit adultery,
commit sacrilege - Sin grievously against thy neighbour, thyself, God.
St. Paul had shown the gentiles, first their sins against God, then
against themselves, then against their neighbours. He now inverts the
order: for sins against God are the most glaring in an heathen, but not
in a Jew. Thou that abhorrest idols - Which all the Jews did, from the
time of the Babylonish captivity. Thou committest sacrilege - Doest what
is worse, robbing Him "who is God over all" of the glory which is due to
him. None of these charges were rashly advanced against the Jews of that
age; for, as their own historian relates, some even of the priests lived
by rapine, and others in gross uncleanness. And as for sacrilegiously
robbing God and his altar, it had been complained of ever since Malachi;
so that the instances are given with great propriety and judgment.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p21">24. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lii. 5" id="i.vii.iii-p21.1" parsed="|Isa|52|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.52.5">Isaiah lii,
5</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p22">25. Circumcision indeed profiteth - He does not say,
justifies. How far it profited is shown in the third and fourth
chapters. Thy circumcision is become uncircumcision - is so already in
effect. Thou wilt have no more benefit by it than if thou hadst never
received it. The very same observation holds with regard to baptism.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p23">26. If the uncircumcision - That is, a person
uncircumcised. Keep the law - Walk agreeably to it. Shall not his
uncircumcision be counted for circumcision - In the sight of God?</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p24">27. Yea, the uncircumcision that is by nature - Those who
are, literally speaking, uncircumcised. Fulfilling the law - As to the
substance of it. Shall judge thee - Shall condemn thee in that day. Who
by the letter and circumcision - Who having the bare, literal, external
circumcision, transgressest the law.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p25">28. For he is not a Jew - In the most important sense, that
is, one of God's beloved people. Who is one in outward show only;
neither is that the true, acceptable circumcision, which is apparent in
the flesh.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iii-p26">29. But he is a Jew - That is, one of God's people. Who is
one inwardly - In the secret recesses of his soul. And the acceptable
circumcision is that of the heart - Referring to <scripRef passage="Deut. xxx. 6" id="i.vii.iii-p26.1" parsed="|Deut|30|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.30.6">Deut. xxx, 6</scripRef>; the putting away all inward impurity. This is seated in the
spirit, the inmost soul, renewed by the Spirit of God. And not in the
letter - Not in the external ceremony. Whose praise is not from men, but
from God - The only searcher of the heart.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="13.22%" prev="i.vii.iii" next="i.vii.v" id="i.vii.iv">
<h3 id="i.vii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans III" id="i.vii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.3" /> 

<p id="i.vii.iv-p1">1. What then, may some say, is the advantage of the Jew, or
of the circumcision - That is, those that are circumcised, above the
gentiles?</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p2">2. Chiefly in that they were intrusted with the oracles of
God - The scriptures, in which are so great and precious promises. Other
prerogatives will follow, chap. ix, 4-5. St. Paul here singles out this
by which, after removing the objection, he will convict them so much the
more.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p3">3. Shall their unbelief disannul the faithfulness of God -
Will he not still make good his promises to them that do believe?</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p4">4. <scripRef passage="Psalm ii. 4" id="i.vii.iv-p4.1" parsed="|Ps|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.2.4">Psalm ii,
4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p5">5. But, it may be farther objected, if our unrighteousness
be subservient to God's glory, is it not unjust in him to punish us for
it? I speak as a man - As human weakness would be apt to speak.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p6">6. God forbid - By no means. If it were unjust in God to
punish that unrighteousness which is subservient to his own glory, how
should God judge the world - Since all the unrighteousness in the world
will then commend the righteousness of God.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p7">7. But, may the objector reply, if the truth of God hath
abounded - Has been more abundantly shown. Through my lie - If my lie,
that is, practice contrary to truth, conduces to the glory of God, by
making his truth shine with superior advantage. Why am I still judged as
a sinner - Can this be said to be any sin at all? Ought I not to do what
would otherwise be evil, that so much "good may come?" To this the
apostle does not deign to give a direct answer, but cuts the objector
short with a severe reproof.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p8">8. Whose condemnation is just - The condemnation of all who
either speak or act in this manner. So the apostle absolutely denies the
lawfulness of " doing evil," any evil, "that good may come."</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p9">9. What then - Here he resumes what he said, verse 1. <scripRef passage="Rom. iii. 1" id="i.vii.iv-p9.1" parsed="|Rom|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.3.1">Rom. iii, 1</scripRef>. Under sin - Under the guilt and power of it: the Jews, by
transgressing the written law; the gentiles, by transgressing the law of
nature.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p10">10. As it is written - That all men are under sin appears
from the vices which have raged in all ages. St. Paul therefore rightly
cites David and Isaiah, though they spoke primarily of their own age,
and expressed what manner of men God sees, when he "looks down from
heaven;" not what he makes them by his grace. There is none righteous -
This is the general proposition. The particulars follow: their
dispositions and designs, ver. 11, 12; their discourse, ver. 13, 14;
their actions, ver. 16-18. <scripRef passage="Psalm xiv. 1" id="i.vii.iv-p10.1" parsed="|Ps|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.14.1">Psalm xiv,
1</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p11">11. There is none that understandeth - The things of
God.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p12">12. They have all turned aside - From the good way. They
are become unprofitable - Helpless impotent, unable to profit either
themselves or others.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p13">13. Their throat - Is noisome and dangerous as an open
sepulchre. Observe the progress of evil discourse, proceeding out of the
heart, through the throat, tongue, lips, till the whole mouth is filled
therewith. The poison of asps - Infectious, deadly backbiting,
tale-bearing, evil-speaking, is under (for honey is on) their lips. An
asp is a venomous kind of serpent. <scripRef passage="Psalm v. 9" id="i.vii.iv-p13.1" parsed="|Ps|5|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.5.9">Psalm
v, 9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Psalm cxl. 3" id="i.vii.iv-p13.2" parsed="|Ps|140|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.140.3">Psalm cxl,
3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p14">14. Cursing - Against God. Bitterness - Against their
neighbour. <scripRef passage="Psalm x. 7" id="i.vii.iv-p14.1" parsed="|Ps|10|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.10.7">Psalm x, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p15">15. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lix. 7, 8" id="i.vii.iv-p15.1" parsed="|Isa|59|7|59|8" osisRef="Bible:Isa.59.7-Isa.59.8">Isaiah lix, 7,
8</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p16">17. Of peace - Which can only spring from
righteousness.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p17">18. The fear of God is not before their eyes - Much less is
the love of God in their heart. <scripRef passage="Psalm xxxvi. 1" id="i.vii.iv-p17.1" parsed="|Ps|36|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.36.1">Psalm
xxxvi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p18">19. Whatsoever the law - The Old Testament. Saith, it saith
to them that are under the law - That is, to those who own its
authority; to the Jews, and not the gentiles. St. Paul quoted no
scripture against them, but pleaded with them only from the light of
nature. Every mouth - Full of bitterness, ver. 14, and yet of boasting,
ver. 27. May become guilty - May be fully convicted, and apparently
liable to most just condemnation. These things were written of old, and
were quoted by St. Paul, not to make men criminal, but to prove them
so.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p19">20. No flesh shall be justified - None shall be forgiven
and accepted of God. By the works of the law - On this ground, that he
hath kept the law. St. Paul means chiefly the moral part of it, ver. 9,
19 chap. ii, 21,</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p20">26; &amp;c. which alone is not abolished, ver. 31. And it
is not without reason, that he so often mentions the works of the law,
whether ceremonial or moral; for it was on these only the Jews relied,
being wholly ignorant of those that spring from faith. For by the law is
only the knowledge of sin - But no deliverance either from the guilt or
power of it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p21">21. But now the righteousness of God - That is, the manner
of becoming righteous which God hath appointed. Without the law -
Without that previous obedience which the law requires; without
reference to the law, or dependence on it. Is manifested - In the
gospel. Being attested by the Law itself, and by the Prophets - By all
the promises in the Old Testament.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p22">22. To all - The Jews. And upon all - The gentiles That
believe: for there is no difference - Either as to the need of
justification, or the manner of it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p23">23. For all have sinned - In Adam, and in their own
persons; by a sinful nature, sinful tempers, and sinful actions. And are
fallen short of the glory of God - The supreme end of man; short of his
image on earth, and the enjoyment of him in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p24">24. And are justified - Pardoned and accepted. Freely -
Without any merit of their own. By his grace - Not their own
righteousness or works. Through the redemption - The price Christ has
paid. Freely by his grace - One of these expressions might have served
to convey the apostle's meaning; but he doubles his assertion, in order
to give us the fullest conviction of the truth, and to impress us with a
sense of its peculiar importance. It is not possible to find words that
should more absolutely exclude all consideration of our own works and
obedience, or more emphatically ascribe the whole of our justification
to free, unmerited goodness.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p25">25. Whom God hath set forth - Before angels and men. A
propitiation - To appease an offended God. But if, as some teach, God
never was offended, there was no need of this propitiation. And, if so,
Christ died in vain. To declare his righteousness - To demonstrate not
only his clemency, but his justice; even that vindictive justice whose
essential character and principal office is, to punish sin. By the
remission of past sins - All the sins antecedent to their believing.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p26">26. For a demonstration of his righteousness - Both of his
justice and mercy. That he might be just - Showing his justice on his
own Son. And yet the merciful justifier of every one that believeth in
Jesus. That he might be just - Might evidence himself to be strictly and
inviolably righteous in the administration of his government, even while
he is the merciful justifier of the sinner that believeth in Jesus. The
attribute of justice must be preserved inviolate; and inviolate it is
preserved, if there was a real infliction of punishment on our saviour.
On this plan all the attributes harmonize; every attribute is glorified,
and not one superseded no, nor so much as clouded.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p27">27. Where is the boasting then of the Jew against the
gentile? It is excluded. By what law? of works? Nay - This would have
left room for boasting. But by the law of faith - Since this requires
all, without distinction, to apply as guilty and helpless sinners, to
the free mercy of God in Christ. The law of faith is that divine
constitution which makes faith, not works, the condition of
acceptance.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p28">28. We conclude then that a man is justified by faith - And
even by this, not as it is a work, but as it receives Christ; and,
consequently, has something essentially different from all our works
whatsoever.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p29">29. Surely of the gentiles also - As both nature and the
scriptures show.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p30">30. Seeing it is one God who - Shows mercy to both, and by
the very same means.</p>

<p id="i.vii.iv-p31">31. We establish the law - Both the authority, purity, and
the end of it; by defending that which the law attests; by pointing out
Christ, the end of it; and by showing how it may be fulfilled in its
purity.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="13.36%" prev="i.vii.iv" next="i.vii.vi" id="i.vii.v">
<h3 id="i.vii.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans IV" id="i.vii.v-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.4" /> 

<p id="i.vii.v-p1">Having proved it by argument, he now proves by example, and
such example as must have greater weight with the Jews than any
other.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.v-p2">1. That justification is by faith:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.v-p3">2. That it is free for the gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p4">1. That our father Abraham hath found - Acceptance with
God. According to the flesh - That is, by works.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p5">2. The meaning is, If Abraham had been justified by works,
he would have had room to glory. But he had not room to glory. Therefore
he was not justified by works.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p6">3. Abraham believed God - That promise of God concerning
the numerousness of his seed, <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 5, 7" id="i.vii.v-p6.1" parsed="|Gen|15|5|0|0;|Gen|15|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.5 Bible:Gen.15.7">Gen. xv,
5, 7</scripRef>; but especially the promise concerning Christ, <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 3" id="i.vii.v-p6.2" parsed="|Gen|12|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.3">Gen. xii, 3</scripRef>, through whom all nations should be blessed. And it was
imputed to him for righteousness - God accepted him as if he had been
altogether righteous. <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 6" id="i.vii.v-p6.3" parsed="|Gen|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.6">Gen. xv, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p7">4. Now to him that worketh - All that the law requires, the
reward is no favour, but an absolute debt. These two examples are
selected and applied with the utmost judgment and propriety. Abraham was
the most illustrious pattern of piety among the Jewish patriarchs. David
was the most eminent of their kings. If then neither of these was
justified by his own obedience, if they both obtained acceptance with
God, not as upright beings who might claim it, but as sinful creatures
who must implore it, the consequence is glaring It is such as must
strike every attentive understanding, and must affect every individual
person.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p8">5. But to him that worketh not - It being impossible he
should without faith. But believeth, his faith is imputed to him for
righteousness - Therefore God's affirming of Abraham, that faith was
imputed to him for righteousness, plainly shows that he worked not; or,
in other words, that he was not justified by works, but by faith only.
Hence we see plainly how groundless that opinion is, that holiness or
sanctification is previous to our justification. For the sinner, being
first convinced of his sin and danger by the Spirit of God, stands
trembling before the awful tribunal of divine justice; and has nothing
to plead, but his own guilt, and the merits of a Mediator. Christ here
interposes; justice is satisfied; the sin is remitted, and pardon is
applied to the soul, by a divine faith wrought by the Holy Ghost, who
then begins the great work of inward sanctification. Thus God justifies
the ungodly, and yet remains just, and true to all his attributes! But
let none hence presume to "continue in sin;" for to the impenitent, God
"is a consuming fire." On him that justifieth the ungodly - If a man
could possibly be made holy before he was justified, it would entirely
set his justification aside; seeing he could not, in the very nature of
the thing, be justified if he were not, at that very time, ungodly.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p9">6. So David also - David is fitly introduced after Abraham,
because be also received and delivered down the promise. Affirmeth - A
man is justified by faith alone, and not by works. Without works-That
is, without regard to any former good works supposed to have been done
by him.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p10">7. Happy are they whose sins are covered - With the veil of
divine mercy. If there be indeed such a thing as happiness on earth, it
is the portion of that man whose iniquities are forgiven, and who enjoys
the manifestation of that pardon. Well may he endure all the afflictions
of life with cheerfulness, and look upon death with comfort. O let us
not contend against it, but earnestly pray that this happiness may be
ours! <scripRef passage="Psalm xxxii. 1, 2" id="i.vii.v-p10.1" parsed="|Ps|32|1|32|2" osisRef="Bible:Ps.32.1-Ps.32.2">Psalm xxxii, 1,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p11">9. This happiness - Mentioned by Abraham and David. On the
circumcision - Those that are circumcised only. Faith was imputed to
Abraham for righteousness - This is fully consistent with our being
justified, that is, pardoned and accepted by God upon our believing, for
the sake of what Christ hath done and suffered. For though this, and
this alone, be the meritorious cause of our acceptance with God, yet
faith may be said to be "imputed to us for righteousness," as it is the
sole condition of our acceptance. We may observe here, forgiveness, not
imputing sin, and imputing righteousness, are all one.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p12">10. Not in circumcision - Not after he was circumcised; for
he was justified before Ishmael was born, <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 1-21" id="i.vii.v-p12.1" parsed="|Gen|15|1|15|21" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.1-Gen.15.21">Gen. xv, 1-21</scripRef>; but he was not circumcised till Ishmael was thirteen years
old, <scripRef passage="Gen. xvii. 25" id="i.vii.v-p12.2" parsed="|Gen|17|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.17.25">Gen. xvii, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p13">11. And - After he was justified. He received the sign of
circumcision - Circumcision, which was a sign or token of his being in
covenant with God. A seal - An assurance on God's part, that he
accounted him righteous, upon his believing, before he was circumcised.
Who believe in uncircumcision - That is, though they are not
circumcised.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p14">12. And the father of the circumcision - Of those who are
circumcised, and believe as Abraham did. To those who believe not,
Abraham is not a father, neither are they his seed.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p15">13. The promise, that he should be the heir of the world -
Is the same as that he should be "the father of all nations," namely, of
those in all nations who receive the blessing. The whole world was
promised to him and them conjointly. Christ is the heir of the world,
and of all things; and so are all Abraham's seed, all that believe in
him with the faith of Abraham</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p16">14. If they only who are of the law - Who have kept the
whole law. Are heirs, faith is made void - No blessing being to be
obtained by it; and so the promise is of no effect.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p17">15. Because the law - Considered apart from that grace,
which though it was in fact mingled with it, yet is no part of the legal
dispensation, is so difficult, and we so weak and sinful, that, instead
of bringing us a blessing, it only worketh wrath; it becomes to us an
occasion of wrath, and exposes us to punishment as transgressors. Where
there is no law in force, there can be no transgression of it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p18">16. Therefore it - The blessing. Is of faith, that it might
be of grace - That it might appear to flow from the free love of God,
and that the promise might be firm, sure, and effectual, to all the
spiritual seed of Abraham; not only Jews, but gentiles also, if they
follow his faith.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p19">17. Before God - Though before men nothing of this
appeared, those nations being then unborn. As quickening the dead - The
dead are not dead to him and even the things that are not, are before
God. And calling the things that are not - Summoning them to rise into
being, and appear before him. The seed of Abraham did not then exist;
yet God said, "So shall thy seed be." A man can say to his servant
actually existing, Do this; and he doeth it: but God saith to the light,
while it does not exist, Go forth; and it goeth. <scripRef passage="Gen. xvii. 5" id="i.vii.v-p19.1" parsed="|Gen|17|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.17.5">Gen. xvii, 5</scripRef>. 18-21. The Apostle shows the power and excellence of that
faith to which he ascribes justification. Who against hope - Against all
probability, believed and hoped in the promise. The same thing is
apprehended both by faith and hope; by faith, as a thing which God has
spoken; by hope, as a good thing which God has promised to us. So shall
thy seed be - Both natural and spiritual, as the stars of heaven for
multitude. <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 5" id="i.vii.v-p19.2" parsed="|Gen|15|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.5">Gen. xv, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p20">23. On his account only - To do personal honour to him.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p21">24. But on ours also - To establish us in seeking
justification by faith, and not by works; and to afford a full answer to
those who say that, " to be justified by works means only, by Judaism;
to be justified by faith means, by embracing Christianity, that is, the
system of doctrines so called." Sure it is that Abraham could not in
this sense be justified either by faith or by works; and equally sure
that David (taking the words thus) was justified by works, and not by
faith. Who raised up Jesus from the dead - As he did in a manner both
Abraham and Sarah. If we believe on him who raised up Jesus - God the
Father therefore is the proper object of justifying faith. It is
observable, that St. Paul here, in speaking both of our faith and of the
faith of Abraham, puts a part for the whole. And he mentions that part,
with regard to Abraham, which would naturally affect the Jews most.</p>

<p id="i.vii.v-p22">25. Who was delivered - To death. For our offenses - As an
atonement for them. And raised for our justification - To empower us to
receive that atonement by faith.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="13.50%" prev="i.vii.v" next="i.vii.vii" id="i.vii.vi">
<h3 id="i.vii.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans V" id="i.vii.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.5" /> 

<p id="i.vii.vi-p1">1. Being justified by faith - This is the sum of the
preceding chapters. We have peace with God - Being enemies to God no
longer, ver. 10; neither fearing his wrath, ver. 9. We have peace, hope,
love, and power over sin, the sum of the fifth, sixth, seventh, and
eighth chapters. These are the fruits of justifying faith: where these
are not, that faith is not.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p2">2. Into this grace - This state of favour.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p3">3. We glory in tribulations also - Which we are so far from
esteeming a mark of God's displeasure, that we receive them as tokens of
his fatherly love, whereby we are prepared for a more exalted happiness.
The Jews objected to the persecuted state of the Christians as
inconsistent with the people of the Messiah. It is therefore with great
propriety that the apostle so often mentions the blessings arising from
this very thing.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p4">4. And patience works more experience of the sincerity of
our grace, and of God's power and faithfulness.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p5">5. Hope shameth us not - That is, gives us the highest
glorying. We glory in this our hope, because the love of God is shed
abroad in our hearts - The divine conviction of God's love to us, and
that love to God which is both the earnest and the beginning of heaven.
By the Holy Ghost - The efficient cause of all these present blessings,
and the earnest of those to come.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p6">6. How can we now doubt of God's love? For when we were
without strength - Either to think, will, or do anything good. In due
time - Neither too soon nor too late; but in that very point of time
which the wisdom of God knew to be more proper than any other. Christ
died for the ungodly - Not only to set them a pattern, or to procure
them power to follow it. It does not appear that this expression, of
dying for any one, has any other signification than that of rescuing the
life of another by laying down our own.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p7">7. A just man - One who gives to all what is strictly their
due The good man - One who is eminently holy; full of love, of
compassion, kindness, mildness, of every heavenly and amiable temper.
Perhaps-one-would-even-dare to die - Every word increases the
strangeness of the thing, and declares even this to be something great
and unusual.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p8">8. But God recommendeth - A most elegant expression. Those
are wont to be recommended to us, who were before either unknown to, or
alienated from, us. While we were sinners - So far from being good, that
we were not even just.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p9">9. By his blood - By his bloodshedding. We shall be saved
from wrath through him - That is, from all the effects of the wrath of
God. But is there then wrath in God? Is not wrath a human passion? And
how can this human passion be in God? We may answer this by another
question: Is not love a human passion? And how can this human passion be
in God? But to answer directly: wrath in man, and so love in man, is a
human passion. But wrath in God is not a human passion; nor is love, as
it is in God. Therefore the inspired writers ascribe both the one and
the other to God only in an analogical sense.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p10">10. If - As sure as; so the word frequently signifies;
particularly in this and the eighth chapter. We shalt be saved -
Sanctified and glorified. Through his life - "Whoever liveth to make
intercession for us."</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p11">11. And not only so, but we also glory - The whole
sentence, from the third to the eleventh verse, may be taken together
thus: We not only "rejoice in hope of the glory of God," but also in the
midst of tribulations we glory in God himself through our Lord Jesus
Christ, by whom we have now received the reconciliation.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p12">12. Therefore - This refers to all the preceding discourse;
from which the apostle infers what follows. He does not therefore
properly make a digression, but returns to speak again of sin and of
righteousness. As by one man - Adam; who is mentioned, and not Eve, as
being the representative of mankind. Sin entered into the world - Actual
sin, and its consequence, a sinful nature. And death - With all its
attendants. It entered into the world when it entered into being; for
till then it did not exist. By sin - Therefore it could not enter before
sin. Even so - Namely, by one man. In that - So the word is used also, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. v. 4" id="i.vii.vi-p12.1" parsed="|2Cor|5|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.5.4">2 Cor. v, 4</scripRef>. All sinned - In Adam. These words assign the reason why
death came upon all men; infants themselves not excepted, in that all
sinned.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p13">13. For until the law sin was in the world - All, I say,
had sinned, for sin was in the world long before the written law; but, I
grant, sin is not so much imputed, nor so severely punished by God,
where there is no express law to convince men of it. Yet that all had
sinned, even then, appears in that all died.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p14">14. Death reigned - And how vast is his kingdom! Scarce can
we find any king who has as many subjects, as are the kings whom he hath
conquered. Even over them that had not sinned after the likeness of
Adam's transgression - Even over infants who had never sinned, as Adam
did, in their own persons; and over others who had not, like him, sinned
against an express law. Who is the figure of him that was to come - Each
of them being a public person, and a federal head of mankind. The one,
the fountain of sin and death to mankind by his offense; the other, of
righteousness and life by his free gift. Thus far the apostle shows the
agreement between the first and second Adam: afterward he shows the
differences between them. The agreement may be summed up thus: As by one
man sin entered into the world, and death by sin; so by one man
righteousness entered into the world, and life by righteousness. As
death passed upon all men, in that all had sinned; so life passed upon
all men, (who are in the second Adam by faith,) in that all are
justified. And as death through the sin of the first Adam reigned even
over them who had not sinned after the likeness of Adam's transgression;
so through the righteousness of Christ, even those who have not obeyed,
after the likeness of his obedience, shall reign in life. We may add, As
the sin of Adam, without the sins which we afterwards committed, brought
us death; so the righteousness of Christ, without the good works which
we afterwards perform, brings us life: although still every good, as
well as evil, work, will receive its due reward.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p15">15. Yet not - St. Paul now describes the difference between
Adam and Christ; and that much more directly and expressly than the
agreement between them. Now the fall and the free gift differ,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vi-p16">1. In amplitude, ver. 15.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vi-p17">2. He from whom sin came, and He from whom
the free gift came, termed also "the gift of righteousness," differ in
power, ver. 16.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vi-p18">3. The reason of both is subjoined, ver.
17.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vi-p19">4. This premised, the offense and the free
gift are compared, with regard to their effect, ver. 18, and with regard
to their cause, ver. 19.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p20">16. The sentence was by one offense to Adam's condemnation
- Occasioning the sentence of death to pass upon him, which, by
consequence, overwhelmed his posterity. But the free gift is of many
offenses unto justification - Unto the purchasing it for all men,
notwithstanding many offenses.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p21">17. There is a difference between grace and the gift. Grace
is opposed to the offense; the gift, to death, being the gift of
life.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p22">18. Justification of life - Is that sentence of God, by
which a sinner under sentence of death is adjudged to life.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p23">19. As by the disobedience of one man many (that is, all
men) were constituted sinners - Being then in the loins of their first
parent, the common head and representative of them all. So by the
obedience of one - By his obedience unto death; by his dying for us.
Many - All that believe. Shall be constituted righteous - Justified,
pardoned.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p24">20. The law came in between - The offense and the free
gift. That the offense might abound - That is, the consequence (not the
design) of the law's coming in was, not the taking away of sin, but the
increase of it. Yet where sin abounded, grace did much more abound - Not
only in the remission of that sin which Adam brought on us, but of all
our own; not only in remission of sins, but infusion of holiness; not
only in deliverance from death, but admission to everlasting life, a far
more noble and excellent life than that which we lost by Adam's
fall.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vi-p25">21. That as sin had reigned - so grace also might reign -
Which could not reign before the fall; before man had sinned. Through
righteousness to eternal life by Jesus Christ our Lord - Here is pointed
out the source of all our blessings, the rich and free grace of God. The
meritorious cause; not any works of righteousness of man, but the alone
merits of our Lord Jesus Christ. The effect or end of all; not only
pardon, but life; divine life, leading to glory.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="13.65%" prev="i.vii.vi" next="i.vii.viii" id="i.vii.vii">
<h3 id="i.vii.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans VI" id="i.vii.vii-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.6" /> 

<p id="i.vii.vii-p1">1. The apostle here sets himself more fully to vindicate
his doctrine from the consequence above suggested, chap. iii, 7, 8. He
had then only in strong terms denied and renounced it: here he removes
the very foundation thereof.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p2">2. Dead to sin - Freed both from the guilt and from the
power of it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p3">3. As many as have been baptized into Jesus Christ have
been baptized into his death - In baptism we, through faith, are
ingrafted into Christ; and we draw new spiritual life from this new
root, through his Spirit, who fashions us like unto him, and
particularly with regard to his death and resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p4">4. We are buried with him - Alluding to the ancient manner
of baptizing by immersion. That as Christ was raised from the dead by
the glory - Glorious power. Of the Father, so we also, by the same
power, should rise again; and as he lives a new life in heaven, so we
should walk in newness of life. This, says the apostle, our very baptism
represents to us.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p5">5. For - Surely these two must go together; so that if we
are indeed made conformable to his death, we shall also know the power
of his resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p6">6. Our old man - Coeval with our being, and as old as the
fall; our evil nature; a strong and beautiful expression for that entire
depravity and corruption which by nature spreads itself over the whole
man, leaving no part uninfected. This in a believer is crucified with
Christ, mortified, gradually killed, by virtue of our union with him.
That the body of sin - All evil tempers, words, and actions, which are
the "members" of the "old man," <scripRef passage="Colossians iii. 5" id="i.vii.vii-p6.1" parsed="|Col|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.3.5">Colossians iii, 5</scripRef>, might be destroyed.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p7">7. For he that is dead - With Christ. Is freed from the
guilt of past, and from the power of present, sin, as dead men from the
commands of their former masters.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p8">8. Dead with Christ - Conformed to his death, by dying to
sin.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p9">10. He died to sin - To atone for and abolish it. He liveth
unto God - A glorious eternal life, such as we shall live also.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p10">12. Let not sin reign even in your mortal body - It must be
subject to death, but it need not be subject to sin.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p11">13. Neither present your members to sin - To corrupt
nature, a mere tyrant. But to God - Your lawful King.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p12">14. Sin shall not have dominion over you - It has neither
right nor power. For ye are not under the law - A dispensation of terror
and bondage, which only shows sin, without enabling you to conquer it.
But under grace - Under the merciful dispensation of the gospel, which
brings complete victory over it to every one who is under the powerful
influences of the Spirit of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p13">17. The form of doctrine into which ye have been delivered
- Literally it is, The mould into which ye have been delivered; which,
as it contains a beautiful allusion, conveys also a very instructive
admonition; intimating that our minds, all pliant and ductile, should be
conformed to the gospel precepts, as liquid metal, take the figure of
the mould into which they are cast.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p14">18. Being then set free from sin - We may see the apostles
method thus far at one view: - Chap. Ver.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vii-p15">1. Bondage to sin chap. iii, 9</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vii-p16">2. The knowledge of sin by the law; a sense
of God's wrath; inward death chap. iii, 20</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vii-p17">3. The Revelation of the righteousness of God
in Christ through the gospel chap. iii, 21</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vii-p18">4. The center of all, faith, embracing that
righteousness chap. iii, 22</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vii-p19">5. Justification, whereby God forgives all
past sin, and freely accepts the sinner chap. iii, 24</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vii-p20">6. The gift of the Holy Ghost; a sense of
chap. v, 5, God's love new inward life ver. 4</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.vii-p21">7. The free service of righteousness ver.
12</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p22">19. I speak after the manner of men - Thus it is necessary
that the scripture should let itself down to the language of men.
Because of the weakness of your flesh - Slowness of understanding flows
from the weakness of the flesh, that is, of human nature. As ye have
presented your members servants to uncleanness and iniquity unto
iniquity, so now present your members servants of righteousness unto
holiness - Iniquity (whereof uncleanness is an eminent part) is here
opposed to righteousness; and unto iniquity is the opposite of unto
holiness. Righteousness here is a conformity to the divine will;
holiness, to the whole divine nature. Observe, they who are servants of
righteousness go on to holiness; but they who are servants to iniquity
get no farther. Righteousness is service, because we live according to
the will of another; but liberty, because of our inclination to it, and
delight in it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p23">20. When ye were the servants of sin, ye were free from
righteousness - In all reason, therefore, ye ought now to be free from
unrighteousness; to be as uniform and zealous in serving God as ye were
in serving the devil.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p24">21. Those things - He speaks of them as afar off.</p>

<p id="i.vii.vii-p25">23. Death - Temporal, spiritual, and eternal. Is the due
wages of sin; but eternal life is the gift of God - The difference is
remarkable. Evil works merit the reward they receive: good works do not.
The former demand wages: the latter accept a free gift.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="13.74%" prev="i.vii.vii" next="i.vii.ix" id="i.vii.viii">
<h3 id="i.vii.viii-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans VII" id="i.vii.viii-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.7" /> 

<p id="i.vii.viii-p1">1. The apostle continues the comparison between the former
and the present state of a believer, and at the same time endeavours to
wean the Jewish believers from their fondness for the Mosaic law. I
speak to them that know the law - To the Jews chiefly here. As long - So
long, and no longer. As it liveth - The law is here spoken of, by a
common figure, as a person, to which, as to an husband, life and death
are ascribed. But he speaks indifferently of the law being dead to us,
or we to it, the sense being the same.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p2">2. She is freed from the law of her husband - From that law
which gave him a peculiar property in her.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p3">4. Thus ye also - Are now as free from the Mosaic law as an
husband is, when his wife is dead. By the body of Christ - Offered up;
that is, by the merits of his death, that law expiring with him.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p4">5. When ye were in the flesh - Carnally minded, in a state
of nature; before we believed in Christ. Our sins which were by the law
- Accidentally occasioned, or irritated thereby. Wrought in our members
- Spread themselves all over the whole man.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p5">6. Being dead to that whereby we were held - To our old
husband, the law. That we might serve in newness of spirit - In a new,
spiritual manner. And not in the oldness of the letter - Not in a bare
literal, external way, as we did before.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p6">7. What shall we say then - This is a kind of a digression,
to the beginning of the next chapter, wherein the apostle, in order to
show in the most lively manner the weakness and inefficacy of the law,
changes the person and speaks as of himself, concerning the misery of
one under the law. This St. Paul frequently does, when he is not
speaking of his own person, but only assuming another character, chap.
iii, 5, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. x. 30" id="i.vii.viii-p6.1" parsed="|1Cor|10|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10.30">1 Cor. x, 30</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. iv. 6" id="i.vii.viii-p6.2" parsed="|1Cor|4|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.4.6">1 Cor. iv, 6</scripRef>. The character here assumed is that of a man, first ignorant
of the law, then under it and sincerely, but ineffectually, striving to
serve God. To have spoken this of himself, or any true believer, would
have been foreign to the whole scope of his discourse; nay, utterly
contrary thereto, as well as to what is expressly asserted, chap. viii,
2. Is the law sin - Sinful in itself, or a promoter of sin. I had not
known lust - That is, evil desire. I had not known it to be a sin; nay,
perhaps I should not have known that any such desire was in me: it did
not appear, till it was stirred up by the prohibition.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p7">8. But sin - My inbred corruption. Taking occasion by the
commandment - Forbidding, but not subduing it, was only fretted, and
wrought in me so much the more all manner of evil desire. For while I
was without the knowledge of the law, sin was dead - Neither so
apparent, nor so active; nor was I under the least apprehensions of any
danger from it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p8">9. And I was once alive without the law - Without the close
application of it. I had much life, wisdom, virtue, strength: so I
thought. But when the commandment - That is, the law, a part put for the
whole; but this expression particularly intimates its compulsive force,
which restrains, enjoins, urges, forbids, threatens. Came - In its
spiritual meaning, to my heart, with the power of God. Sin revived, and
I died - My inbred sin took fire, and all my virtue and strength died
away; and I then saw myself to be dead in sin, and liable to death
eternal.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p9">10. The commandment which was intended for life - Doubtless
it was originally intended by God as a grand means of preserving and
increasing spiritual life, and leading to life everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p10">11. Deceived me - While I expected life by the law, sin
came upon me unawares and slew all my hopes.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p11">12. The commandment - That is, every branch of the law. Is
holy, and just, and good - It springs from, and partakes of, the holy
nature of God; it is every way just and right in itself; it is designed
wholly for the good of man.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p12">13. Was then that which is good made the cause of evil to
me; yea, of death, which is the greatest of evil? Not so. But it was
sin, which was made death to me, inasmuch as it wrought death in me even
by that which is good - By the good law. So that sin by the commandment
became exceeding sinful - The consequence of which was, that inbred sin,
thus driving furiously in spite of the commandment, became exceeding
sinful; the guilt thereof being greatly aggravated.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p13">14. I am carnal - St. Paul, having compared together the
past and present state of believers, that "in the flesh," ver. 5, and
that "in the spirit," ver. 6, in answering two objections, (Is then the
law sin? ver. 7, and, Is the law death? ver. 13,) interweaves the whole
process of a man reasoning, groaning, striving, and escaping from the
legal to the evangelical state. This he does from ver. 7, to the end of
this chapter. Sold under sin - Totally enslaved; slaves bought with
money were absolutely at their master's disposal.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p14">16. It is good - This single word implies all the three
that were used before, ver. 12, "holy, just, and good."</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p15">17. It is no more I that can properly be said to do it, but
rather sin that dwelleth in me - That makes, as it were, another person,
and tyrannizes over me.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p16">18. In my flesh - The flesh here signifies the whole man as
he is by nature.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p17">21. I find then a law - An inward constraining power,
flowing from the dictate of corrupt nature.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p18">22. For I delight in the law of God - This is more than "I
consent to," ver. 16. The day of liberty draws near. The inward man -
Called the mind, ver. 23, 25.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p19">23. But I see another law in my members - Another inward
constraining power of evil inclinations and bodily appetites. Warring
against the law of my mind - The dictate of my mind, which delights in
the law of God. And captivating me - In spite of all my resistance</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p20">24. Wretched man that I am - The struggle is now come to
the height; and the man, finding there is no help in himself, begins
almost unawares to pray, Who shall deliver me? He then seeks and looks
for deliverance, till God in Christ appears to answer his question. The
word which we translate deliver, implies force. And indeed without this
there can be no deliverance. The body of this death - That is, this body
of death; this mass of sin, leading to death eternal, and cleaving as
close to me as my body to my soul. We may observe, the deliverance is
not wrought yet.</p>

<p id="i.vii.viii-p21">25. I thank God through Jesus Christ our Lord - That is,
God will deliver me through Christ. But the apostle, as his frequent
manner is, beautifully interweaves his assertion with thanksgiving; the
hymn of praise answering in a manner to the voice of sorrow, "Wretched
man that I am!" So then - He here sums up the whole, and concludes what
he began, ver. 7. I myself - Or rather that I, the person whom I am
personating, till this deliverance is wrought. Serve the law of God with
my mind - My reason and conscience declare for God. But with my flesh
the law of sin - But my corrupt passions and appetites still rebel. The
man is now utterly weary of his bondage, and upon the brink of
liberty.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="13.86%" prev="i.vii.viii" next="i.vii.x" id="i.vii.ix">
<h3 id="i.vii.ix-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans VIII" id="i.vii.ix-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.8" /> 

<p id="i.vii.ix-p1">1. There is therefore now no condemnation - Either for
things present or past. Now he comes to deliverance and liberty. The
apostle here resumes the thread of his discourse, which was interrupted,
chap. vii, 7.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p2">2. The law of the Spirit - That is, the gospel. Hath freed
me from the law of sin and death - That is, the Mosaic dispensation.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p3">3. For what the law - Of Moses. Could not do, in that it
was weak through the flesh - Incapable of conquering our evil nature. If
it could, God needed not to have sent his own Son in the likeness of
sinful flesh - We with our sinful flesh were devoted to death. But God
sending his own Son, in the likeness of that flesh, though pure from
sin, condemned that sin which was in our flesh; gave sentence, that sin
should be destroyed, and the believer wholly delivered from it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p4">4. That the righteousness of the law - The holiness it
required, described, ver. 11. Might be fulfilled in us, who walk not
after the flesh, but after the Spirit - Who are guided in all our
thoughts, words, and actions, not by corrupt nature, but by the Spirit
of God. From this place St. Paul describes primarily the state of
believers, and that of unbelievers only to illustrate this.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p5">5. They that are after the flesh - Who remain under the
guidance of corrupt nature. Mind the things of the flesh - Have their
thoughts and affections fixed on such things as gratify corrupt nature;
namely, on things visible and temporal; on things of the earth, on
pleasure, (of sense or imagination,) praise, or riches. But they who are
after the Spirit - Who are under his guidance. Mind the things of the
Spirit - Think of, relish, love things invisible, eternal; the things
which the Spirit hath revealed, which he works in us, moves us to, and
promises to give us.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p6">6. For to be carnally minded - That is, to mind the things
of the flesh. Is death - The sure mark of spiritual death, and the way
to death everlasting. But to be spiritually minded - That is, to mind
the things of the Spirit. Is life - A sure mark of spiritual life, and
the way to life everlasting. And attended with peace - The peace of God,
which is the foretaste of life everlasting; and peace with God, opposite
to the enmity mentioned in the next verse.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p7">7. Enmity against God - His existence, power, and
providence.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p8">8. They who are in the flesh - Under the government of
it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p9">9. In the Spirit - Under his government. If any man have
not the Spirit of Christ - Dwelling and governing in him. He is none of
his - He is not a member of Christ; not a Christian; not in a state of
salvation. A plain, express declaration, which admits of no exception.
He that hath ears to hear, let him hear!</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p10">10. Now if Christ be in you - Where the Spirit of Christ
is, there is Christ. The body indeed is dead - Devoted to death. Because
of sin - Heretofore committed. But the Spirit is life - Already truly
alive. Because of righteousness - Now attained. From ver. 13, St. Paul,
having finished what he had begun, chap. vi, 1, describes purely the
state of believers.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p11">12. We are not debtors to the flesh - We ought not to
follow it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p12">13. The deeds of the flesh - Not only evil actions, but
evil desires, tempers, thoughts. If ye mortify - Kill, destroy these. Ye
shall live - The life of faith more abundantly here, and hereafter the
life of glory.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p13">14. For as many as are led by the Spirit of God - In all
the ways of righteousness. They are the sons of God - Here St. Paul
enters upon the description of those blessings which he comprises, ver.
30, in the word glorified; though, indeed, he does not describe mere
glory, but that which is still mingled with the cross. The sum is,
through sufferings to glory.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p14">15. For ye - Who are real Christians. Have not received the
spirit of bondage - The Holy Ghost was not properly a spirit of bondage,
even in the time of the Old Testament. Yet there was something of
bondage remaining even in those who then had received the Spirit. Again
- As the Jews did before. We - All and every believer. Cry - The word
denotes a vehement speaking, with desire, confidence, constancy. Abba,
Father - The latter word explains the former. By using both the Syriac
and the Greek word, St. Paul seems to point out the joint cry both of
the Jewish and gentile believers. The spirit of bondage here seems
directly to mean, those operations of the Holy Spirit by which the soul,
on its first conviction, feels itself in bondage to sin, to the world,
to Satan, and obnoxious to the wrath of God. This, therefore, and the
Spirit of adoption, are one and the same Spirit, only manifesting itself
in various operations, according to the various circumstances of the
persons.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p15">16. The same Spirit beareth witness with our spirit - With
the spirit of every true believer, by a testimony distinct from that of
his own spirit, or the testimony of a good conscience. Happy they who
enjoy this clear and constant.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p16">17. Joint heirs - That we may know it is a great
inheritance which God will give us for he hath given a great one to his
Son. If we suffer with him - Willingly and cheerfully, for
righteousness' sake. This is a new proposition, referring to what
follows.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p17">18. For I reckon - This verse gives the reason why he but
now mentioned sufferings and glory. When that glory "shall be revealed
in us," then the sons of God will be revealed also.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p18">19. For the earnest expectation - The word denotes a lively
hope of something drawing near, and a vehement longing after it. Of the
creation - Of all visible creatures, believers excepted, who are spoken
of apart; each kind, according as it is capable. All these have been
sufferers through sin; and to all these (the finally impenitent
excepted) shall refreshment redound from the glory of the children of
God. Upright heathens are by no means to be excluded from this earnest
expectation: nay, perhaps something of it may at some times be found
even in the vainest of men; who (although in the hurry of life they
mistake vanity for liberty, and partly stifle, partly dissemble, their
groans, yet) in their sober, quiet, sleepless, afflicted hours, pour
forth many sighs in the ear of God.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p19">20. The creation was made subject to vanity - Abuse,
misery, and corruption. By him who subjected it - Namely, God, <scripRef passage="Gen. iii. 17" id="i.vii.ix-p19.1" parsed="|Gen|3|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.3.17">Gen. iii, 17</scripRef>, v, 29. Adam only made it liable to the sentence which God
pronounced; yet not without hope.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p20">21. The creation itself shall be delivered - Destruction is
not deliverance: therefore whatsoever is destroyed, or ceases to be, is
not delivered at all. Will, then, any part of the creation be destroyed?
Into the glorious liberty - The excellent state wherein they were
created.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p21">22. For the whole creation groaneth together - With joint
groans, as it were with one voice. And travaileth - Literally, is in the
pains of childbirth, to be delivered of the burden of the curse. Until
now - To this very hour; and so on till the time of deliverance.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p22">23. And even we, who have the first-fruits of the Spirit -
That is, the Spirit, who is the first-fruits of our inheritance. The
adoption - Persons who had been privately adopted among the Roman were
often brought forth into the forum, and there publicly owned as their
sons by those who adopted them. So at the general resurrection, when the
body itself is redeemed from death, the sons of God shall be publicly
owned by him in the great assembly of men and angels. The redemption of
our body - From corruption to glory and immortality.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p23">24. For we are saved by hope - Our salvation is now only in
hope. We do not yet possess this full salvation.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p24">26. Likewise the Spirit - Nay, not only the universe, not
only the children of God, but the Spirit of God also himself, as it
were, groaneth, while he helpeth our infirmities, or weaknesses. Our
understandings are weak, particularly in the things of God our desires
are weak; our prayers are weak. We know not - Many times. What we should
pray for - Much less are we able to pray for it as we ought: but the
Spirit maketh intercession for us - In our hearts, even as Christ does
in heaven. With groanings - The matter of which is from ourselves, but
the Spirit forms them; and they are frequently inexpressible, even by
the faithful themselves.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p25">27. But he who searcheth the hearts - Wherein the Spirit
dwells and intercedes. Knoweth - Though man cannot utter it. What is the
mind of the Spirit, for he maketh intercession for the saints - Who are
near to God. According to God - According to his will, as is worthy of
God. and acceptable to him.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p26">28. And we know - This in general; though we do not always
know particularly what to pray for. That all things - Ease or pain,
poverty or riches, and the ten thousand changes of life. Work together
for good - Strongly and sweetly for spiritual and eternal good. To them
that are called according to his purpose - His gracious design of saving
a lost world by the death of his Son. This is a new proposition. St.
Paul, being about to recapitulate the whole blessing contained in
justification, (termed "glorification," ver. 30,) first goes back to the
purpose or decree of God, which is frequently mentioned in holy writ. To
explain this (nearly in the words of an eminent writer) a little more at
large:-When a man has a work of time and importance before him, he
pauses, consults, and contrives; and when he has laid a plan, resolves
or decrees to proceed accordingly. Having observed this in ourselves, we
are ready to apply it to God also; and he, in condescension to us has
applied it to himself. The works of providence and redemption are vast
and stupendous, and therefore we are apt to conceive of God as
deliberating and consulting on them, and then decreeing to act according
to "the counsel of his own will;" as if, long before the world was made,
he had been concerting measures both as to the making and governing of
it, and had then writ down his decrees, which altered not, any more than
the laws of the Medes and Persians. Whereas, to take this consulting and
decreeing in a literal sense, would be the same absurdity as to ascribe
a real human body and human passions to the ever-blessed God. This is
only a popular representation of his infallible knowledge and
unchangeable wisdom; that is, he does all things as wisely as a man can
possibly do, after the deepest consultation, and as steadily pursues the
most proper method as one can do who has laid a scheme beforehand. But
then, though the effects be such as would argue consultation and
consequent decrees in man, yet what need of a moment's consultation in
Him who sees all things at one view? Nor had God any more occasion to
pause and deliberate, and lay down rules for his own conduct from all
eternity, than he has now. What was there any fear of his mistaking
afterwards, if he had not beforehand prepared decrees, to direct him
what he was to do? Will any man say, he was wiser before the creation
than since? or had he then more leisure, that he should take that
opportunity to settle his affairs, and make rules (or himself, from
which he was never to vary? He has doubtless the same wisdom and all
other perfections at this day which he had from eternity; and is now as
capable of making decrees, or rather has no more occasion for them now
than formerly: his understanding being always equally clear and bright,
his wisdom equally infallible.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p27">29. Whom he foreknew, he also predestinated conformable to
the image of his Son - Here the apostle declares who those are whom he
foreknew and predestinated to glory; namely, those who are conformable
to the image of his Son. This is the mark of those who are foreknown and
will be glorified,</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p28"><scripRef passage="2 Tim. ii. 19" id="i.vii.ix-p28.1" parsed="|2Tim|2|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.2.19">2 Tim. ii, 19</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Phil. iii. 10, 21" id="i.vii.ix-p28.2" parsed="|Phil|3|10|0|0;|Phil|3|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.3.10 Bible:Phil.3.21">Phil. iii, 10, 21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p29">30. Them he - In due time. Called - By his gospel and his
Spirit. And whom he called - When obedient to the heavenly calling, <scripRef passage="Acts xxvi. 19" id="i.vii.ix-p29.1" parsed="|Acts|26|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.26.19">Acts xxvi, 19</scripRef>. He also justified - Forgave and accepted. And whom he
justified - Provided they "continued in his goodness," chap. xi, 22, he
in the end glorified - St. Paul does not affirm, either here or in any
other part of his writings, that precisely the same number of men are
called, justified, and glorified. He does not deny that a believer may
fall away and be cut off between his special calling and his
glorification, chap. xi, 22. Neither does he deny that many are called
who never are justified. He only affirms that this is the method whereby
God leads us step by step toward heaven. He glorified - He speaks as one
looking back from the goal, upon the race of faith. Indeed grace, as it
is glory begun, is both an earnest and a foretaste of eternal glory.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p30">31. What shall we say then to these things - Related in the
third, fifth, and eighth chapters? As if he had said, We cannot go,
think, or wish anything farther. If God be for us - Here follow four
periods, one general and three particular. Each begins with glorying in
the grace of God, which is followed by a question suitable to it,
challenging all opponents to all which, "I am persuaded," &amp;c., is a
general answer. The general period is, If God be for us, who can be
against us? The first particular period, relating to the past time, is,
He that spared not his own Son, how shall he not freely give us all
things? The second, relating to the present, is, It is God that
justifieth. Who is he that condemneth? The third, relating to the
future, is, It is Christ that died - Who shall separate us from the love
of Christ?</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p31">32. He that - This period contains four sentences: He
spared not his own Son; therefore he will freely give us all things. He
delivered him up for us all; therefore, none can lay anything to our
charge. Freely - For all that follows justification is a free gift also.
All things - Needful or profitable for us.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p32">33. God's elect - The above-cited author observes, that
long before the coming of Christ the heathen world revolted from the
true God, and were therefore reprobated, or rejected. But the nation of
the Jews were chosen to be the people of God, and were therefore styled,
"the children" or "sons of God," <scripRef passage="Deut. xiv. 1" id="i.vii.ix-p32.1" parsed="|Deut|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.14.1">Deut.
xiv, 1</scripRef>; "holy people," <scripRef passage="Deut. vii. 6; xiv. 2" id="i.vii.ix-p32.2" parsed="|Deut|7|6|0|0;|Deut|14|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.7.6 Bible:Deut.14.2">Deut. vii, 6; xiv,
2</scripRef>; "a chosen seed," <scripRef passage="Deut. iv. 37" id="i.vii.ix-p32.3" parsed="|Deut|4|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.4.37">Deut.
iv, 37</scripRef>; "the elect," <scripRef passage="Isaiah xli. 8, 9; xliii. 10" id="i.vii.ix-p32.4" parsed="|Isa|41|8|41|9;|Isa|43|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.41.8-Isa.41.9 Bible:Isa.43.10">Isaiah xli, 8, 9; xliii,
10</scripRef>; "the called of God," <scripRef passage="Isaiah xlviii. 12" id="i.vii.ix-p32.5" parsed="|Isa|48|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.48.12">Isaiah xlviii, 12</scripRef>. And these titles were given to all the nation of Israel,
including both good and bad. Now the gospel having the most strict
connection with the Books of the Old Testament, where these phrases
frequently occur; and our Lord and his apostles being native Jews, and
beginning to preach in the land of Israel, the language in which they
preached would of course abound with the phrases of the Jewish nation.
And hence it is easy to see why such of them as would not receive him
were styled reprobated. For they no longer continued to be the people of
God; whereas this and those other honourable titles were continued to
all such Jews as embraced Christianity. And the same appellations which
once belonged to the Jewish nation were now given to the gentile
Christians also together with which they were invested with all the
privileges of "the chosen people of God;" and nothing could cut them off
from these but their own wilful apostasy. It does not appear that even
good men were ever termed God's elect till above two thousand years from
the creation. God's electing or choosing the nation of Israel, and
separating them from the other nations, who were sunk in idolatry and
all wickedness, gave the first occasion to this sort of language. And as
the separating the Christians from the Jews was a like event, no wonder
it was expressed in like words and phrases only with this difference,
the term elect was of old applied to all the members of the visible
church; whereas in the New Testament it is applied only to the members
of the invisible.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p33">34. Yea rather, that is risen - Our faith should not stop
at his death, but be exercised farther on his resurrection, kingdom,
second coming. Who maketh intercession for us - Presenting there his
obedience, his sufferings, his prayers, and our prayers sanctified
through him.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p34">35. Who shall separate us from the love of Christ - Toward
us? Shall affliction or distress - He proceeds in order, from less
troubles to greater: can any of these separate us from his protection in
it; and, if he sees good, deliverance from it?</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p35">36. All the day - That is, every day, continually. We are
accounted - By our enemies; by ourselves. <scripRef passage="Psalm xliv. 22" id="i.vii.ix-p35.1" parsed="|Ps|44|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.44.22">Psalm xliv, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p36">37. We more than conquer - We are not only no losers, but
abundant gainers, by all these trials. This period seems to describe the
full assurance of hope.</p>

<p id="i.vii.ix-p37">38. I am persuaded - This is inferred from the
thirty-fourth verse, in an admirable order: - Neither death" shall hurt
us; For "Christ is dead:" "Nor life;" 'is risen" Nor angels, nor
principalities, nor powers; nor things pre- sent, nor things to come;"
"is at the right hand of God:" "Nor height, nor depth, nor any other
creature;" "maketh intercession for us." Neither death - Terrible as it
is to natural men; a violent death in particular, ver. 36. Nor life -
With all the affliction and distress it can bring, ver. 35; or a long,
easy life; or all living men. Nor angels - Whether good (if it were
possible they should attempt it) or bad, with all their wisdom and
strength. Nor principalities, nor powers - Not even those of the highest
rank, or the most eminent power. Nor things present - Which may befall
us during our pilgrimage; or the whole world, till it passeth away. Nor
things to come - Which may occur either when our time on earth is past,
or when time itself is at an end, as the final judgment, the general
conflagration, the everlasting fire. Nor height, nor depth - The former
sentence respected the differences of times; this, the differences of
places. How many great and various things are contained in these words,
we do not, need not, cannot know yet. The height - In St. Paul's sublime
style, is put for heaven. The depth - For the great abyss: that is,
neither the heights, I will not say of walls, mountains, seas, but, of
heaven itself, can move us; nor the abyss itself, the very thought of
which might astonish the boldest creature. Nor any creature - Nothing
beneath the Almighty; visible enemies he does not even deign to name.
Shall be able - Either by force, ver. 35; or by any legal claim, ver.
33, &amp;c. To separate us from the love of God in Christ - Which will
surely save, protect, deliver us who believe in, and through, and from,
them all.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="14.19%" prev="i.vii.ix" next="i.vii.xi" id="i.vii.x">
<h3 id="i.vii.x-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans IX" id="i.vii.x-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.9" /> 

<p id="i.vii.x-p1">In this chapter St. Paul, after strongly declaring his love
and esteem for them, sets himself to answer the grand objection of his
countrymen; namely, that the rejection of the Jews and reception of the
gentiles was contrary to the word of God. That he had not here the least
thought of personal election or reprobation is manifest,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.x-p2">1. Because it lay quite wide of his design,
which was this, to show that God's rejecting the Jews and receiving the
gentiles was consistent with his word</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.x-p3">2. Because such a doctrine would not only
have had no tendency to convince, but would have evidently tended to
harden, the Jews;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.x-p4">3. Because when he sums up his argument in
the close of the chapter, he has not one word, or the least intimation,
about it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p5">1. In Christ - This seems to imply an appeal to him. In the
Holy Ghost - Through his grace.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p6">2. I have great sorrow - A high degree of spiritual sorrow
and of spiritual Joy may consist together, chap. viii, 39. By declaring
his sorrow for the unbelieving Jews, who excluded themselves from all
the blessings he had enumerated, he shows that what he was now about to
speak, he did not speak from any prejudice to them.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p7">3. I could wish - Human words cannot fully describe the
motions of souls that are full of God. As if he had said, I could wish
to suffer in their stead; yea, to be an anathema from Christ in their
place. In how high a sense he wished this, who can tell, unless himself
had been asked and had resolved the question? Certainly he did not then
consider himself at all, but only others and the glory of God. The thing
could not be; yet the wish was pious and solid; though with a tacit
condition, if it were right and possible.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p8">4. Whose is the adoption, &amp;c. - He enumerates six
prerogatives, of which the first pair respect God the Father, the second
Christ, the third the Holy Ghost. The adoption and the glory - That is,
Israel is the first-born child of God, and the God of glory is their
God, <scripRef passage="Deut. iv. 7" id="i.vii.x-p8.1" parsed="|Deut|4|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.4.7">Deut. iv, 7</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Psalm cvi. 20" id="i.vii.x-p8.2" parsed="|Ps|106|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.106.20">Psalm cvi, 20</scripRef>. These are relative to each other. At once God is the Father
of Israel, and Israel are the people of God. He speaks not here of the
ark, or any corporeal thing. God himself is "the glory of his people
Israel." And the covenants, and the giving of the law - The covenant was
given long before the law. It is termed covenants, in the plural,
because it was so often and so variously repeated, and because there
were two dispositions of it, <scripRef passage="Gal. iv. 24" id="i.vii.x-p8.3" parsed="|Gal|4|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.4.24">Gal. iv, 24</scripRef>, frequently called two covenants; the one promising, the
other exhibiting the promise. And the worship, and the promises - The
true way of worshipping God; and all the promises made to the
fathers.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p9">5. To the preceding, St. Paul now adds two more
prerogatives. Theirs are the fathers - The patriarchs and holy men of
old, yea, the Messiah himself. Who is over all, God blessed forever -
The original words imply the self-existent, independent Being, who was,
is, and is to come. Over all - The supreme; as being God, and
consequently blessed forever. No words can more dearly express his
divine, supreme majesty, and his gracious sovereignty both over Jews
and, gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p10">6. Not as if - The Jews imagined that the word of God must
fail if all their nation were not saved. This St. Paul now refutes, and
proves that the word itself had foretold their falling away. The word of
God - The promises of God to Israel. Had fallen to the ground - This
could not be. Even now, says the apostle, some enjoy the promises; and
hereafter "all Israel shall be saved." This is the sum of the ninth,
tenth, and eleventh chapters. For - Here he enters upon the proof of it.
All are not Israel, who are of Israel - The Jews vehemently maintained
the contrary; namely, that all who were born Israelites, and they only,
were the people of God. The former part of this assertion is refuted
here, the latter, ver. 24, &amp;c. The sum is, God accepts all
believers, and them only; and this is no way contrary to his word. Nay,
he hath declared in his word, both by types and by express testimonies,
that believers are accepted as the "children of the promise," while
unbelievers are rejected, though they are "children after the flesh."
All are not Israel - Not in the favour of God. Who are lineally
descended of Israel.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p11">7. Neither because they are lineally the seed of Abraham,
will it follow that they are all children of God - This did not hold
even in Abraham's own family; and much less in his remote descendants.
But God then said, In Isaac shall thy seed be called - That is, Isaac,
not Ishmael, shall be called thy seed; that seed to which the promise is
made.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p12">8. That is, Not the children, &amp;c. - As if he had said,
This is a clear type of things to come; showing us, that in all
succeeding generations, not the children of the flesh, the lineal
descendants of Abraham, but the children of the promise, they to whom
the promise is made, that is, believers, are the children of God. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxi. 12" id="i.vii.x-p12.1" parsed="|Gen|21|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.21.12">Gen. xxi, 12</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p13">9. For this is the word of the promise - By the power of
which Isaac was conceived, and not by the power of nature. Not,
Whosoever is born of thee shall be blessed, but, At this time - Which I
now appoint. I will come, and Sarah shall have a son - And he shall
inherit the blessing. <scripRef passage="Gen. xviii. 10" id="i.vii.x-p13.1" parsed="|Gen|18|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.18.10">Gen. xviii,
10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p14">10. And that God's blessing does not belong to all the
descendants of Abraham, appears not only by this instance, but by that
of Esau and Jacob, who was chosen to inherit the blessing, before either
of them had done good or evil. The apostle mentions this to show, that
neither were their ancestors accepted through any merit of their own.
That the purpose of God according to election might stand - Whose
purpose was, to elect or choose the promised seed. Not of works - Not
for any preceding merit in him he chose. But of him that called - Of his
own good pleasure who called to that privilege whom he saw good.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p15">12. The elder - Esau. Shall serve the younger - Not in
person, for he never did; but in his posterity. Accordingly the Edomites
were often brought into subjection by the Israelites. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxv. 23" id="i.vii.x-p15.1" parsed="|Gen|25|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.25.23">Gen. xxv, 23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p16">13. As it is written - With which word in Genesis, spoken
so long before, that of Malachi agrees. I have loved Jacob - With a
peculiar love; that is, the Israelites, the posterity of Jacob. And I
have, comparatively, hated Esau - That is, the Edomites, the posterity
of Esau. But observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.x-p17">1. This does not relate to the person of
Jacob or Esau</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.x-p18">2. Nor does it relate to the eternal state
either of them or their posterity. Thus far the apostle has been proving
his proposition, namely, that the exclusion of a great part of the seed
of Abraham, yea, and of Isaac, from the special promises of God, was so
far from being impossible, that, according to the scriptures themselves,
it had actually happened. He now introduces and refutes an objection. <scripRef passage="Mal. i. 2, 3" id="i.vii.x-p18.1" parsed="|Mal|1|2|1|3" osisRef="Bible:Mal.1.2-Mal.1.3">Mal. i, 2, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p19">14. Is there injustice with God - Is it unjust in God to
give Jacob the blessing rather than Esau? or to accept believers, and
them only. God forbid - In no wise. This is well consistent with
justice; for he has a right to fix the terms on which he will show
mercy, according to his declaration to Moses, petitioning for all the
people, after they had committed idolatry with the golden calf. I will
have mercy on whom I will have mercy - According to the terms I myself
have fixed. And I will have compassion on whom I will have compassion -
Namely, on those only who submit to my terms, who accept of it in the
way that I have appointed.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p20">15. <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxiii. 19" id="i.vii.x-p20.1" parsed="|Exod|33|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.33.19">Exod. xxxiii,
19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p21">16. It - The blessing. Therefore is not of him that
willeth, nor of him that runneth - It is not the effect either of the
will or the works of man, but of the grace and power of God. The will of
man is here opposed to the grace of God, and man's running, to the
divine operation. And this general declaration respects not only Isaac
and Jacob, and the Israelites in the time of Moses, but likewise all the
spiritual children of Abraham, even to the end of the world.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p22">17. Moreover - God has an indisputable right to reject
those who will not accept the blessings on his own terms. And this he
exercised in the case of Pharaoh; to whom, after many instances of
stubbornness and rebellion, he said, as it is recorded in scripture, For
this very thing have I raised thee up - That is, Unless thou repent,
this will surely be the consequence of my raising thee up, making thee a
great and glorious king, that my power will be shown upon thee, (as
indeed it was, by overwhelming him and his army in the sea,) and my name
declared through all the earth - As it is at this day. Perhaps this may
have a still further meaning. It seems that God was resolved to show his
power over the river, the insects, other animals, (with the natural
causes of their health, diseases, life, and death,) over the meteors,
the air, the sun, (all of which were worshipped by the Egyptians, from
whom other nations learned their idolatry,) and at once over all their
gods, by that terrible stroke of slaying all their priests, and their
choicest victims, the firstborn of man and beast; and all this with a
design, not only to deliver his people Israel, (for which a single act
of omnipotence would have sufficed,) but to convince the Egyptians, that
the objects of their worship were but the creatures of Jehovah, and
entirely in his power, and to draw them and the neighbouring nations,
who should hear of all these wonders, from their idolatry, to worship
the one God. For the execution of this design, (in order to the display
of the divine power over the various objects of their worship, in
variety of wonderful acts, which were at the same time just punishments
for their cruel oppression of the Israelites,) God was pleased to raise
to the throne of an absolute monarchy, a man, not whom he had made
wicked on purpose, but whom he found so, the proudest, the most daring
and obstinate of all the Egyptian princes; and who, being incorrigible,
well deserved to be set up in that situation, where the divine judgments
fell the heaviest. <scripRef passage="Exod. ix. 16" id="i.vii.x-p22.1" parsed="|Exod|9|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.9.16">Exod. ix,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p23">18. So then - That is, accordingly he does show mercy on
his own terms, namely, on them that believe. And whom he willeth -
Namely, them that believe not. He hardeneth - Leaves to the hardness of
their hearts.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p24">19. Why doth he still find fault - The particle still is
strongly expressive of the objector's sour, morose murmuring. For who
hath resisted his will - The word his likewise expresses his surliness
and aversion to God, whom he does not even deign to name.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p25">20. Nay, but who art thou, O man - Little, impotent,
ignorant man. That repliest against God - That accusest God of
injustice, for himself fixing the terms on which he will show mercy?
Shall the thing formed say to him that formed it, Why hast thou made me
thus - Why hast thou made me capable of honour and immortality, only by
believing?</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p26">21. Hath not the potter power over the clay - And much more
hath not God power over his creatures, to appoint one vessel, namely,
the believer, to honour, and another, the unbeliever, to dishonour? If
we survey the right which God has over us, in a more general way, with
regard to his intelligent creatures, God may be considered in two
different views, as Creator, Proprietor, and Lord of all; or, as their
moral Governor, and Judge. God, as sovereign Lord and Proprietor of all,
dispenses his gifts or favours to his creatures with perfect wisdom, but
by no rules or methods of proceeding that we are acquainted with. The
time when we shall exist, the country where we shall live, our parents,
our constitution of body and turn of mind; these, and numberless other
circumstances, are doubtless ordered with perfect wisdom, but by rules
that lie quite out of our sight. But God's methods of dealing with us,
as our Governor and Judge, are dearly revealed and perfectly known;
namely, that he will finally reward every man according to his works:
"He that believeth shalt be saved, and he that believeth not shall be
damned." Therefore, though "He hath mercy on whom he willeth, and whom
he willeth he hardeneth," that is, suffers to be hardened in consequence
of their obstinate wickedness; yet his is not the will of an arbitrary,
capricious, or tyrannical being. He wills nothing but what is infinitely
wise and good; and therefore his will is a most proper rule of judgment.
He will show mercy, as he hath assured us, to none but true believers,
nor harden any but such as obstinately refuse his mercy. <scripRef passage="Jer. xviii. 6, 7" id="i.vii.x-p26.1" parsed="|Jer|18|6|18|7" osisRef="Bible:Jer.18.6-Jer.18.7">Jer. xviii, 6, 7</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p27">22. What if God, being willing - Referring to ver. 18, 19.
That is, although it was now his will, because of their obstinate
unbelief, To show his wrath - Which necessarily presupposes sin. And to
make his power known - This is repeated from the seventeenth verse. Yet
endured - As he did Pharaoh. With much longsuffering - Which should have
led them to repentance. The vessels of wrath - Those who had moved his
wrath by still rejecting his mercy. Fitted for destruction - By their
own wilful and final impenitence. Is there any injustice in this?</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p28">23. That he might make known - What if by showing such
longsuffering even to "the vessels of wrath," he did the more abundantly
show the greatness of his glorious goodness, wisdom, and power, on the
vessels of mercy; on those whom he had himself, by his grace, prepared
for glory. Is this any injustice?</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p29">24. Even us - Here the apostle comes to the other
proposition, of grace free for all, whether Jew or gentile. Of the Jews
- This he treats of, ver. 25. Of the gentiles - Treated of in the same
verse.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p30">25. Beloved - As a spouse. Who once was not beloved -
Consequently, not unconditionally elected. This relates directly to the
final restoration of the Jews. <scripRef passage="Hosea ii. 23" id="i.vii.x-p30.1" parsed="|Hos|2|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.2.23">Hosea
ii, 23</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p31">26. There shall they be called the sons of God - So that
they need not leave their own country and come to Judea. <scripRef passage="Hosea i. 10" id="i.vii.x-p31.1" parsed="|Hos|1|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.1.10">Hosea i, 10</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p32">27. But Isaiah testifies, that (as many gentiles will be
accepted, so) many Jews will be rejected; that out of all the thousands
of Israel, a remnant only shall be saved. This was spoken originally of
the few that were saved from the ravage of Sennacherib's army. <scripRef passage="Isaiah x. 22, 23" id="i.vii.x-p32.1" parsed="|Isa|10|22|10|23" osisRef="Bible:Isa.10.22-Isa.10.23">Isaiah x, 22, 23</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p33">28. For he is finishing or cutting short his account - In
rigorous justice, will leave but a small remnant. There will be so
general a destruction, that but a small number will escape.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p34">29. As Isaiah had said before - Namely, <scripRef passage="Isaiah i. 9" id="i.vii.x-p34.1" parsed="|Isa|1|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.1.9">Isaiah i, 9</scripRef>, concerning those who were besieged in Jerusalem by Rezin
and Pekah. Unless the Lord had left us a seed - Which denotes,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.x-p35">1. The present paucity:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.vii.x-p36">2. The future abundance. We had been as Sodom
- So that it is no unexampled thing for the main body of the Jewish
nation to revolt from God, and perish in their sin.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p37">30. What shall we say then - What is to be concluded from
all that has been said but this, That the gentiles, who followed not
after righteousness - Who a while ago had no knowledge of, no care or
thought about, it. Have attained to righteousness - Or justification.
Even the righteousness which is by faith. This is the first conclusion
we may draw from the preceding observations. The second is, that Israel
- The Jews Although following after the law of righteousness - That law
which, duly used, would have led them to faith, and thereby to
righteousness. Have not attained to the law of righteousness - To that
righteousness or justification which is one great end of the law</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p38">32. And wherefore have they not? Is it because God
eternally decreed they should not? There is nothing like this to be met
with but agreeable to his argument the apostle gives us this good reason
for it, Because they sought it not by faith - Whereby alone it could be
attained. But as it were - In effect, if not professsedly, by works. For
they stumbled at that stumblingstone - Christ crucified.</p>

<p id="i.vii.x-p39">33. As it is written - Foretold by their own prophet.
Behold, I lay in Zion - I exhibit in my church, what, though it is in
truth the only sure foundation of happiness, yet will be in fact a
stumblingstone and rock of offense - An occasion of ruin to many,
through their obstinate unbelief. <scripRef passage="Isaiah viii. 14" id="i.vii.x-p39.1" parsed="|Isa|8|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.8.14">Isaiah viii, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxviii. 16" id="i.vii.x-p39.2" parsed="|Isa|28|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.28.16">Isaiah xxviii, 16</scripRef></p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="14.47%" prev="i.vii.x" next="i.vii.xii" id="i.vii.xi">
<h3 id="i.vii.xi-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans X" id="i.vii.xi-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.10" /> 

<p id="i.vii.xi-p1">1. My prayer to God is, that they may be saved - He would
not have prayed for this, had they been absolutely reprobated.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p2">2. They have a zeal, but not according to knowledge - They
had zeal without knowledge; we have knowledge without zeal.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p3">3. For they being ignorant of the righteousness of God - Of
the method God has established for the justification of a sinner. And
seeking to establish their own righteousness - Their own method of
acceptance with God. Have not submitted to the righteousness of God -
The way of justification which he hath fixed.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p4">4. For Christ is the end of the law - The scope and aim of
it. It is the very design of the law, to bring men to believe in Christ
for justification and salvation. And he alone gives that pardon and life
which the law shows the want of, but cannot give. To every one - Whether
Jew or gentile, treated of, ver. 11, &amp;c. That believeth - Treated
of, ver. 5.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p5">5. For Moses describeth the only righteousness which is
attainable by the law, when he saith, The man who doeth these things
shall live by them - that is, he that perfectly keeps all these precepts
in every point, he alone may claim life and salvation by them. But this
way of justification is impossible to any who have ever transgressed any
one law in any point. <scripRef passage="Lev. xviii. 5" id="i.vii.xi-p5.1" parsed="|Lev|18|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.18.5">Lev. xviii,
5</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p6">6. But the righteousness which is by faith - The method of
becoming righteous by believing. Speaketh a very different language, and
may be considered as expressing itself thus: (to accommodate to our
present subject the words which Moses spake, touching the plainness of
his law:) Say not in thy heart, Who shall ascend into heaven, as if it
were to bring Christ down: or, Who shall descend into the grave, as if
it were to bring him again from the dead - Do not imagine that these
things are to be done now, in order to procure thy pardon and salvation.
<scripRef passage="Deut. xxx. 14" id="i.vii.xi-p6.1" parsed="|Deut|30|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.30.14">Deut. xxx, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p7">8. But what saith he - Moses. Even these words, so
remarkably applicable to the subject before us. All is done ready to thy
hand. The word is nigh thee - Within thy reach; easy to be understood,
remembered, practiced. This is eminently true of the word of faith - The
gospel. Which we preach - The sum of which is, If thy heart believe in
Christ, and thy life confess him, thou shalt be saved.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p8">9. If thou confess with thy mouth - Even in time of
persecution, when such a confession may send thee to the lions.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p9">10. For with the heart - Not the understanding only. Man
believeth to righteousness - So as to obtain justification. And with the
mouth confession is made - So as to obtain final salvation. Confession
here implies the whole of outward, as believing does the root of all
inward, religion.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p10">11. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxviii. 16" id="i.vii.xi-p10.1" parsed="|Isa|28|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.28.16">Isaiah xxviii,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p11">12. The same Lord of all is rich - So that his blessings
are never to be exhausted, nor is he ever constrained to hold his hand.
The great truth proposed in ver. 11 is so repeated here, and in ver. 13,
and farther confirmed, ver. 14, 15, as not only to imply, that
"whosoever calleth upon him shall be saved;" but also that the will of
God is, that all should savingly call upon him.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p12">13. <scripRef passage="Joel ii. 32" id="i.vii.xi-p12.1" parsed="|Joel|2|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Joel.2.32">Joel ii,
32</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p13">15. But how shall they preach, unless they be sent - Thus
by a chain of reasoning, from God's will that the gentiles also should
"call upon him," St. Paul infers that the apostles were sent by God to
preach to the gentiles also. The feet - Their very footsteps; their
coming. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lii. 7" id="i.vii.xi-p13.1" parsed="|Isa|52|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.52.7">Isaiah lii, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p14">16. <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 1" id="i.vii.xi-p14.1" parsed="|Isa|53|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.1">Isaiah liii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p15">17. Faith, indeed, ordinarily cometh by hearing; even by
hearing the word of God.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p16">18. But their unbelief was not owing to the want of hearing
For they have heard. Yes verily - So many nations have already heard the
preachers of the gospel, that I may in some sense say of them as David
did of the lights of heaven. <scripRef passage="Psalm xxix. 4" id="i.vii.xi-p16.1" parsed="|Ps|29|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.29.4">Psalm
xxix, 4</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p17">19. But hath not Israel known - They might have known, even
from Moses and Isaiah, that many of the gentiles would be received, and
many of the Jews rejected. I will provoke you to jealousy by them that
are not a nation - As they followed gods that were not gods, so he
accepted in their stead a nation that was not a nation; that is, a
nation that was not in covenant with God. A foolish nation - Such are
all which know not God. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 21" id="i.vii.xi-p17.1" parsed="|Deut|32|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.21">Deut. xxxii,
21</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p18">20. But Isaiah is very bold - And speaks plainly what Moses
but intimated. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxv. 1, 2" id="i.vii.xi-p18.1" parsed="|Isa|65|1|65|2" osisRef="Bible:Isa.65.1-Isa.65.2">Isaiah lxv, 1,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xi-p19">21. An unbelieving and gainsaying people - Just opposite to
those who believed with their hearts, and made confession with their
mouths.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="14.55%" prev="i.vii.xi" next="i.vii.xiii" id="i.vii.xii">
<h3 id="i.vii.xii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans XI" id="i.vii.xii-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.11" /> 

<p id="i.vii.xii-p1">1. Hath God rejected his whole people - All Israel? In no
wise. Now there is "a remnant" who believe, ver. 5; and hereafter "all
Israel will be saved," ver. 26.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p2">2. God hath not rejected that part of his people whom he
foreknew - Speaking after the manner of men. For, in fact, knowing and
foreknowing are the same thing with God, who knows or sees all things at
once, from everlasting to everlasting. Know ye not - That in a parallel
case, amidst a general apostasy, when Elijah thought the whole nation
was fallen into idolatry, God "knew" there was "a remnant" of true
worshippers.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p3">3. <scripRef passage="1 Kings xix. 10" id="i.vii.xii-p3.1" parsed="|1Kgs|19|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.19.10">1 Kings xix,
10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p4">4. To Baal - Nor to the golden calves.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p5">5. According to the election of grace - According to that
gracious purpose of God, "He that believeth shall be saved."</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p6">6. And if by grace, then it is no more of works - Whether
ceremonial or moral. Else grace is no longer grace - The very nature of
grace is lost. And if it be of works, then it is no more grace: else
work is no longer work - But the very nature of it is destroyed. There
is something so absolutely inconsistent between the being justified by
grace, and the being justified by works, that, if you suppose either,
you of necessity exclude the other. For what is given to works is the
payment of a debt; whereas grace implies an unmerited favour. So that
the same benefit cannot, in the very nature of things, be derived from
both.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p7">7. What then - What is the conclusion from the whole? It is
this: that Israel in general hath not obtained justification; but those
of them only who believe. And the rest were blinded - By their own
wilful prejudice.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p8">8. God hath at length withdrawn his Spirit, and so given
them up to a spirit of slumber; which is fulfilled unto this day. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxix. 10" id="i.vii.xii-p8.1" parsed="|Isa|29|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.29.10">Isaiah xxix, 10</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p9">9. And David saith - In that prophetic imprecation, which
is applicable to them, as well as to Judas. A recompence - Of their
preceding wickedness. So sin is punished by sin; and thus the gospel,
which should have fed and strengthened their souls, is become a means of
destroying them. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxix. 22, 23" id="i.vii.xii-p9.1" parsed="|Ps|69|22|69|23" osisRef="Bible:Ps.69.22-Ps.69.23">Psalm lxix, 22,
23</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p10">11. Have they stumbled so as to fall - Totally and finally?
No But by their fall - Or slip: it is a very soft word in the original.
Salvation is come to the gentiles - See an instance of this, <scripRef passage="Acts xiii. 46" id="i.vii.xii-p10.1" parsed="|Acts|13|46|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.13.46">Acts xiii, 46</scripRef>. To provoke them - The Jews themselves, to jealousy.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p11">12. The first part of this verse is treated of, ver. 13,
&amp;c.; the latter, How much more their fulness, (that is, their full
conversion,) ver. 23, &amp;c. So many prophecies refer to this grand
event, that it is surprising any Christian can doubt of it. And these
are greatly confirmed by the wonderful preservation of the Jews as a
distinct people to this day. When it is accomplished, it will be so
strong a demonstration, both of the Old and New Testament Revelation, as
will doubtless convince many thousand Deists, in countries nominally
Christian; of whom there will, of course, be increasing multitudes among
merely nominal Christians. And this will be a means of swiftly
propagating the gospel among Mahometans and Pagans; who would probably
have received it long ago, had they conversed only with real
Christians.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p12">13. I magnify my office - Far from being ashamed of
ministering to the gentiles, I glory therein; the rather, as it may be a
means of provoking my brethren to jealousy.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p13">14. My flesh - My kinsmen.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p14">15. Life from the dead - Overflowing life to the world,
which was dead.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p15">16. And this will surely come to pass. For if the first
fruits be holy, so is the lump - The consecration of them was esteemed
the consecration of all and so the conversion of a few Jews is an
earnest of the conversion of all the rest. And if the root be holy - The
patriarchs from whom they spring, surely God will at length make their
descendants also holy.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p16">17. Thou - O gentile. Being a wild olive tree - Had the
graft been nobler than the stock, yet its dependance on it for life and
nourishment would leave it no room to boast against it. How much less,
when, contrary to what is practiced among men, the wild olive tree is
engrafted on the good!</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p17">18. Boast not against the branches - Do not they do this
who despise the Jews? or deny their future conversion?</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p18">20. They were broken off for unbelief, and thou standest by
faith - Both conditionally, not absolutely: if absolutely, there might
have been room to boast. By faith - The free gift of God, which
therefore ought to humble thee.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p19">21. Be not highminded, but fear - We may observe, this fear
is not opposed to trust, but to pride and security.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p20">22. Else shalt thou - Also, who now "standest by faith," be
both totally and finally cut off.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p21">24. Contrary to nature - For according to nature, we graft
the fruitful branch into the wild stock; but here the wild branch is
grafted into the fruitful stock.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p22">25. St. Paul calls any truth known but to a few, a mystery.
Such had been the calling of the gentiles: such was now the conversion
of the Jews. Lest ye should be wise in your own conceits - Puffed up
with your present advantages; dreaming that ye are the only church; or
that the church of Rome cannot fail. Hardness in part is happened to
Israel, till - Israel therefore is neither totally nor finally rejected.
The fulness of the gentiles be come in - Till there be a vast harvest
amongst the heathens.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p23">26. And so all Israel shall be saved - Being convinced by
the coming of the gentiles. But there will be a still larger harvest
among the gentiles, when all Israel is come in. The deliverer shall come
- Yea, the deliverer is come; but not the full fruit of his coming. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lix. 20" id="i.vii.xii-p23.1" parsed="|Isa|59|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.59.20">Isaiah lix, 20</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p24">28. They are now enemies - To the gospel, to God, and to
themselves, which God permits. For your sake: but as for the election -
That part of them who believe, they are beloved.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p25">29. For the gifts and the calling of God are without
repentance - God does not repent of his gifts to the Jews, or his
calling of the gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p26">32. For God hath shut up all together in disobedience -
Suffering each in their turn to revolt from him. First, God suffered the
gentiles in the early age to revolt, and took the family of Abraham as a
peculiar seed to himself. Afterwards he permitted them to fall through
unbelief, and took in the believing gentiles. And he did even this to
provoke the Jews to jealousy, and so bring them also in the end to
faith. This was truly a mystery in the divine conduct, which the apostle
adores with such holy astonishment.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p27">33. O the depth of the riches, and wisdom, and knowledge of
God - In the ninth chapter, St. Paul had sailed but in a narrow sea: now
he is in the ocean. The depth of the riches is described, ver. 35; the
depth of wisdom, ver. 34; the depth of knowledge, in the latter part of
this verse. Wisdom directs all things to the best end; knowledge sees
that end. How unsearchable are his judgments - With regard to
unbelievers. His ways - With regard to believers. His ways are more upon
a level; His judgments "a great deep." But even his ways we cannot
trace.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p28">34. Who hath known the mind of the Lord - Before or any
farther than he has revealed it. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 13" id="i.vii.xii-p28.1" parsed="|Isa|40|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.13">Isaiah xl, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p29">35. Given to him - Either wisdom or power?</p>

<p id="i.vii.xii-p30">36. Of him - As the Creator. Through him - As the
Preserver. To him - As the ultimate end, are all things. To him be the
glory of his riches, wisdom, knowledge. Amen - A concluding word, in
which the affection of the apostle, when it is come to the height, shuts
up all.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="14.68%" prev="i.vii.xii" next="i.vii.xiv" id="i.vii.xiii">
<h3 id="i.vii.xiii-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans XII" id="i.vii.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.12" /> 

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p1">1. I exhort you - St. Paul uses to suit his exhortations to
the doctrines he has been delivering. So here the general use from the
whole is contained in the first and second verses. The particular uses
follow, from the third verse to the end of the Epistle. By the tender
mercies of God - The whole sentiment is derived from Romans. The
expression itself is particularly opposed to "the wrath of God," chap.
i, 18. It has a reference here to the entire gospel, to the whole
economy of grace or mercy, delivering us from "the wrath of God," and
exciting us to all duty. To present - So chap. vi, 13; xvi, 19; now
actually to exhibit before God. Your bodies - That is, yourselves; a
part is put for the whole; the rather, as in the ancient sacrifices of
beasts, the body was the whole. These also are particularly named in
opposition to that vile abuse of their bodies mentioned, chap. i, 24.
Several expressions follow, which have likewise a direct reference to
other expressions in the same chapter. A sacrifice - Dead to sin and
living - By that life which is mentioned, chap. i, 17; vi, 4, &amp;c.
Holy - Such as the holy law requires, chap. vii, 12. Acceptable - chap.
viii, 8. Which is your reasonable service - The worship of the heathens
was utterly unreasonable, chap. i, 18, &amp;c.; so was the glorying of
the Jews, chap. ii, 3, &amp;c. But a Christian acts in all things by the
highest reason, from the mercy of God inferring his own duty.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p2">2. And be not conformed - Neither in judgment, spirit, nor
behaviour. To this world - Which, neglecting the will of God, entirely
follows its own. That ye may prove - Know by sure trial; which is easily
done by him who has thus presented himself to God. What is that good,
and acceptable, and perfect will of God - The will of God is here to be
understood of all the preceptive part of Christianity, which is in
itself so excellently good, so acceptable to God, and so perfective of
our natures.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p3">3. And I say - He now proceeds to show what that will of
God is. Through the grace which is given to me - He modestly adds this,
lest he should seem to forget his own direction. To every one that is
among you - Believers at Rome. Happy, had they always remembered this!
The measure of faith - Treated of in the first and following chapters,
from which all other gifts and graces flow.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p4">5. So we - All believers. Are one body - Closely connected
together in Christ, and consequently ought to be helpful to each
other.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p5">6. Having then gifts differing according to the grace which
is given us - Gifts are various: grace is one. Whether it be prophecy -
This, considered as an extraordinary gift, is that whereby heavenly
mysteries are declared to men, or things to come foretold. But it seems
here to mean the ordinary gift of expounding scripture. Let us prophesy
according to the analogy of faith - St. Peter expresses it, "as the
oracles of God;" according to the general tenor of them; according to
that grand scheme of doctrine which is delivered therein, touching
original sin, justification by faith, and present, inward salvation.
There is a wonderful analogy between all these; and a close and intimate
connection between the chief heads of that faith "which was once
delivered to the saints." Every article therefore concerning which there
is any question should be determined by this rule; every doubtful
scripture interpreted according to the grand truths which run through
the whole.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p6">7. Ministering - As deacons. He that teacheth -
Catechumens; for whom particular instructers were appointed. He that
exhorteth - Whose peculiar business it was to urge Christians to duty,
and to comfort them in trials.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p7">8. He that presideth - That hath the care of a flock. He
that showeth mercy - In any instance. With cheerfulness - Rejoicing that
he hath such an opportunity.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p8">9. Having spoken of faith and its fruit, ver. 3, &amp;c.,
he comes now to love. The ninth, tenth, and eleventh verses refer to
chapter the seventh; the twelfth verse to chapter the eighth; the
thirteenth verse, of communicating to the saints, whether Jews or
gentiles, to chapter the ninth, &amp;c. Part of the sixteenth verse is
repeated from chap. xi, 25. Abhor that which is evil; cleave to that
which is good - Both inwardly and outwardly, whatever ill-will or danger
may follow.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p9">10. In honour preferring one another - Which you will do,
if you habitually consider what is good in others, and what is evil in
yourselves.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p10">11. Whatsoever ye do, do it with your might. In every
business diligently and fervently serving the Lord - Doing all to God,
not to man.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p11">12. Rejoicing in hope - Of perfect holiness and everlasting
happiness. Hitherto of faith and love; now of hope also, see the fifth
and eighth chapters; afterwards of duties toward others; saints, ver. 13
persecutors, ver. 14 friends, strangers, enemies, ver. 15, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p12">13. Communicate to the necessities of the saints - Relieve
all Christians that are in want. It is remarkable, that the apostle,
treating expressly of the duties flowing from the communion of saints,
yet never says one word about the dead. Pursue hospitality - Not only
embracing those that offer, but seeking opportunities to exercise
it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p13">14. Curse not - No, not in your heart.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p14">15. Rejoice - The direct opposite to weeping is laughter;
but this does not so well suit a Christian.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p15">16. Mind not high things - Desire not riches, honour, or
the company of the great.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p16">17. Provide - Think beforehand; contrive to give as little
offense as may be to any.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p17">19. Dearly beloved - So he softens the rugged spirit.
Revenge not yourselves, but leave that to God. Perhaps it might more
properly be rendered, leave room for wrath; that is, the wrath of God,
to whom vengeance properly belongs. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 35" id="i.vii.xiii-p17.1" parsed="|Deut|32|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.35">Deut. xxxii, 35</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p18">20. Feed him - With your own hand: if it be needful, even
put bread into his mouth. Heap coals of fire upon his head - That part
which is most sensible. "So artists melt the sullen ore of lead, By
heaping coals of fire upon its head; In the kind warmth the metal learns
to glow, And pure from dross the silver runs below." <scripRef passage="Prov. xxv. 21" id="i.vii.xiii-p18.1" parsed="|Prov|25|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.25.21">Prov. xxv, 21</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiii-p19">21. And if you see no present fruit, yet persevere. Be not
overcome with evil - As all are who avenge themselves. But overcome evil
with good. Conquer your enemies by kindness and patience.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="14.79%" prev="i.vii.xiii" next="i.vii.xv" id="i.vii.xiv">
<h3 id="i.vii.xiv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans XIII" id="i.vii.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.13" /> 

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p1">1. St. Paul, writing to the Romans, whose city was the seat
of the empire, speaks largely of obedience to magistrates: and this was
also, in effect, a public apology for the Christian religion. Let every
soul be subject to the supreme powers - An admonition peculiarly needful
for the Jews. Power, in the singular number, is the supreme authority;
powers are they who are invested with it. That is more readily
acknowledged to be from God than these. The apostle affirms it of both.
They are all from God, who constituted all in general, and permits each
in particular by his providence. The powers that be are appointed by God
- It might be rendered, are subordinate to, or, orderly disposed under,
God; implying, that they are God's deputies or vicegerents and
consequently, their authority being, in effect, his, demands our
conscientious obedience.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p2">2. Whosoever resisteth the power - In any other manner than
the laws of the community direct. Shall receive condemnation - Not only
from the magistrate, but from God also.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p3">3. For rulers are - In the general, notwithstanding some
particular exceptions. A terror to evil works - Only. Wouldest thou then
not be afraid - There is one fear which precedes evil actions, and
deters from them: this should always remain. There is another fear which
follows evil actions: they who do well are free from this.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p4">4. The sword - The instrument of capital punishment, which
God authorizes him to inflict.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p5">5. Not only for fear of wrath - That is, punishment from
man. But for conscience' sake - Out of obedience to God.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p6">6. For this cause - Because they are the ministers
(officers) of God for the public good. This very thing - The public
good.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p7">7. To all - Magistrates. Tribute - Taxes on your persons or
estates. Custom - For goods exported or imported. Fear - Obedience.
honour - Reverence. All these are due to the supreme power.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p8">8. From our duty to magistrates he passes on to general
duties. To love one another - An eternal debt, which can never be
sufficiently discharged; but yet if this be rightly performed, it
discharges all the rest. For he that loveth another - As he ought. Hath
fulfilled the whole law - Toward his neighbour.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p9">9. If there be any other - More particular. Commandment -
Toward our neighbour; as there are many in the law. It is summed up in
this - So that if you was not thinking of it, yet if your heart was full
of love, you would fulfil it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p10">10. Therefore love is the fulfilling of the law - For the
same love which restrains from all evil, incites us to all good.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p11">11. And do this - Fulfil the law of love in all the
instances above mentioned. Knowing the season - Full of grace, but
hasting away. That it is high time to awake out of sleep - How
beautifully is the metaphor carried on! This life, a night; the
resurrection, the day; the gospel shining on the heart, the dawn of this
day; we are to awake out of sleep; to rise up and throw away our
night-clothes, fit only for darkness, and put on new; and, being
soldiers, we are to arm, and prepare for fight, who are encompassed with
so many enemies. The day dawns when we receive faith, and then sleep
gives place. Then it is time to rise, to arm, to walk, to work, lest
sleep steal upon us again. Final salvation, glory, is nearer to us now,
than when we first believed - It is continually advancing, flying
forward upon the swiftest wings of time. And that which remains between
the present hour and eternity is comparatively but a moment.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p12">13. Banqueting - Luxurious, elegant feasts.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xiv-p13">14. But put ye on the Lord Jesus Christ - Herein is
contained the whole of our salvation. It is a strong and beautiful
expression for the most intimate union with him, and being clothed with
all the graces which were in him. The apostle does not say, Put on
purity and sobriety, peacefulness and benevolence; but he says all this
and a thousand times more at once, in saying, Put on Christ. And make
not provision - To raise foolish desires, or, when they are raised
already, to satisfy them.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="14.86%" prev="i.vii.xiv" next="i.vii.xvi" id="i.vii.xv">
<h3 id="i.vii.xv-p0.1">XIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans XIV" id="i.vii.xv-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.14" /> 

<p id="i.vii.xv-p1">1. Him that is weak - Through needless scruples. Receive -
With all love and courtesy into Christian fellowship. But not to
doubtful disputations - About questionable points.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p2">2. All things - All sorts of food, though forbidden by the
law.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p3">3. Despise him that eateth not - As over-scrupulous or
superstitious. Judge him that eateth - As profane, or taking undue
liberties. For God hath received him - Into the number of his children,
notwithstanding this.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p4">5. One day above another - As new moons, and other Jewish
festivals. Let every man be fully persuaded - That a thing is lawful,
before he does it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p5">6. Regardeth it to the Lord - That is, out of a principle
of conscience toward God. To the Lord he doth not regard it - He also
acts from a principle of conscience. He that eateth not - Flesh. Giveth
God thanks - For his herbs.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p6">7. None of us - Christians, in the things we do. Liveth to
himself - Is at his own disposal; doeth his own will.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p7">10. Or why dost thou despise thy brother - Hitherto the
apostle as addressed the weak brother: now he speaks to the
stronger.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p8">11. As I live - An oath proper to him, because he only
possesseth life infinite and independent. It is Christ who is here
termed both Lord and God; as it is he to whom we live, and to whom we
die. Every tongue shall confess to God - Shall own him as their rightful
Lord; which shall then only be accomplished in its full extent. The Lord
grant we may find mercy in that day; and may it also be imparted to
those who have differed from us! yea, to those who have censured and
condemned us for things which we have done from a desire to please him,
or refused to do from a fear of offending him. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xlv. 23" id="i.vii.xv-p8.1" parsed="|Isa|45|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.45.23">Isaiah xlv, 23</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p9">13. But judge this rather - Concerning ourselves. Not to
lay a stumblingblock - By moving him to do as thou doest, though against
his conscience. Or a scandal - Moving him to hate or judge thee.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p10">14. I am assured by the Lord Jesus - Perhaps by a
particular Revelation. That there is nothing - Neither flesh nor herbs.
Unclean of itself - Unlawful under the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p11">15. If thy brother is grieved - That is, wounded, led into
sin. Destroy not him for whom Christ died - So we see, he for whom
Christ died may be destroyed. With thy meat - Do not value thy meat more
than Christ valued his life.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p12">16. Let not then your good and lawful liberty be evil
spoken of - By being offensive to others.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p13">17. For the kingdom of God - That is, true religion, does
not consist in external observances. But in righteousness - The image of
God stamped on the heart; the love of God and man, accompanied with the
peace that passeth all understanding, and joy in the Holy Ghost.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p14">18. In these - Righteousness, peace, and joy. Men - Wise
and good men.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p15">19. Peace and edification are closely joined. Practical
divinity tends equally to peace and to edification. Controversial
divinity less directly tends to edification, although sometimes, as they
of old, we cannot build without it, <scripRef passage="Neh. iv. 17" id="i.vii.xv-p15.1" parsed="|Neh|4|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.4.17">Neh.
iv, 17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p16">20. The work of God - Which he builds in the soul by faith,
and in the church by concord. It is evil to that man who eateth with
offense - So as to offend another thereby.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p17">21. Thy brother stumbleth - By imitating thee against his
conscience, contrary to righteousness. Or is offended - At what thou
doest to the loss of his peace. Or made weak - Hesitating between
imitation and abhorrence, to the loss of that joy in the Lord which was
his strength.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p18">22. Hast thou faith - That all things are pure? Have it to
thyself before God - In circumstances like these, keep it to thyself,
and do not offend others by it. Happy is he that condemneth not himself
- By an improper use of even innocent things! and happy he who is free
from a doubting conscience! He that has this may allow the thing, yet
condemn himself for it.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xv-p19">23. Because it is not of faith - He does not believe it
lawful and, in all these cases, whatsoever is not of faith is sin -
Whatever a man does without a full persuasion of its lawfulness, it is
sin to him.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="14.93%" prev="i.vii.xv" next="i.vii.xvii" id="i.vii.xvi">
<h3 id="i.vii.xvi-p0.1">XV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans XV" id="i.vii.xvi-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.15" /> 

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p1">1. We who are strong - Of a clearer judgment, and free from
these scruples. And not to please ourselves - Without any regard to
others.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p2">2. For his good - This is a general word: edification is
one species of good.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p3">3. But bore not only the infirmities, but reproaches, of
his brethren; and so fulfilled that scripture. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxix. 9" id="i.vii.xvi-p3.1" parsed="|Ps|69|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.69.9">Psalm lxix, 9</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p4">4. Aforetime - In the Old Testament. That we through
patience and consolation of the scriptures may have hope - That through
the consolation which God gives us by these, we may have patience and a
joyful hope.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p5">5. According to the power of Christ Jesus.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p6">6. That ye - Both Jews and gentiles, believing with one
mind, and confessing with one mouth.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p7">7. Receive ye one another - Weak and strong, with mutual
love.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p8">8. Now I say - The apostle here shows how Christ received
us. Christ Jesus-Jesus is the name, Christ the surname. The latter was
first known to the Jews; the former, to the gentiles. Therefore he is
styled Jesus Christ, when the words stand in the common, natural order.
When the order is inverted, as here, the office of Christ is more
solemnly considered. Was a servant - Of his Father. Of the circumcision
- For the salvation of the circumcised, the Jews. For the truth of God -
To manifest the truth and fidelity of God.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p9">9. As it is written - In the eighteenth Psalm, here the
gentiles and Jews are spoken of as joining in the worship of the God of
Israel. <scripRef passage="Psalm xviii. 49" id="i.vii.xvi-p9.1" parsed="|Ps|18|49|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.18.49">Psalm xviii,
49</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p10">10. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 43" id="i.vii.xvi-p10.1" parsed="|Deut|32|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.43">Deut. xxxii,
43</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p11">11. <scripRef passage="Psalm cxvii. 1" id="i.vii.xvi-p11.1" parsed="|Ps|117|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.117.1">Psalm cxvii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p12">12. There shall be the root of Jesse - That kings and the
Messiah should spring from his house, was promised to Jesse before it
was to David. In him shall the gentiles hope - Who before had been
"without hope," <scripRef passage="Eph. ii. 12" id="i.vii.xvi-p12.1" parsed="|Eph|2|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.2.12">Eph. ii, 12</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xi. 10" id="i.vii.xvi-p12.2" parsed="|Isa|11|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.11.10">Isaiah xi, 10</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p13">13. Now the God of hope - A glorious title of God, but till
now unknown to the heathens; for their goddess Hope, like their other
idols, was nothing; whose temple at Rome was burned by lightning. It
was, indeed, built again not long after, but was again burned to the
ground.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p14">14. There are several conclusions of this Epistle. The
first begins at this verse; the second, chap. xvi, 1; the third, chap.
xvi, 17; the fourth, chap. xvi, 21; and the fifth, chap. xvi, 25; Ye are
full of goodness - By being created anew. And filled with all knowledge
- By long experience of the things of God. To admonish - To instruct and
confirm.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p15">15. Because of the grace - That is, because I am an apostle
of the gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p16">16. The offering up of the gentiles - As living
sacrifices.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p17">17. I have whereof to glory through Jesus Christ - All my
glorying is in and through him.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p18">18. By word - By the power of the Spirit. By deed - Namely,
through "mighty signs and wonders."</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p19">20. Not where Christ had been named - These places he
generally declined, though not altogether, having an holy ambition (so
the Greek word means) to make the first proclamation of the gospel in
places where it was quite unheard of, in spite of all the difficulty and
dangers that attended it. Lest I should only build upon another man's
foundation - The providence of God seemed in a special manner,
generally, to prevent this, though not entirely, lest the enemies of the
apostle, who sought every occasion to set light by him, should have had
room to say that he was behind other apostles, not being sufficient for
planting of churches himself, but only for preaching where others had
been already; or that he declined the more difficult part of the
ministry</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p20">21. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lii. 15" id="i.vii.xvi-p20.1" parsed="|Isa|52|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.52.15">Isaiah lii,
15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p21">22. Therefore I have been long hindered from coming to you
- Among whom Christ had been named.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p22">23. Having no longer place in these parts - Where Christ
has now been preached in every city.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p23">24. Into Spain - Where the gospel had not yet been
preached. If first I may be somewhat satisfied with your company - How
remarkable is the modesty with which he speaks! They might rather desire
to be satisfied with his. Somewhat satisfied - Intimating the shortness
of his stay; or, perhaps, that Christ alone can throughly satisfy the
soul.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p24">26. The poor of the saints that are in Jerusalem - It can
by no means be inferred from this expression, that the community of
goods among the Christians was then ceased. All that can be gathered
from it is, that in this time of extreme dearth, <scripRef passage="Acts xi. 28, 29" id="i.vii.xvi-p24.1" parsed="|Acts|11|28|11|29" osisRef="Bible:Acts.11.28-Acts.11.29">Acts xi, 28, 29</scripRef>, some of the church in Jerusalem were in want; the rest
being barely able to subsist themselves, but not to supply the
necessities of their brethren.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p25">27. It hath pleased them; and they are their debtors - That
is, they are bound to it, in justice as well as mercy. Spiritual things
- By the preaching of the gospel. Carnal things - Things needful for the
body.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p26">28. When I have sealed to them this fruit - When I have
safely delivered to them, as under seal, this fruit of their brethren's
love. I will go by you into Spain - Such was his design; but it does not
appear that Paul went into Spain. There are often holy purposes in the
minds of good men, which are overruled by the providence of God so as
never to take effect. And yet they are precious in the sight of God.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p27">30. I beseech you by the love of the Spirit - That is, by
the love which is the genuine fruit of the Spirit. To strive together
with me in your prayers - He must pray himself, who would have others
strive together with him in prayer. Of all the apostles, St. Paul alone
is recorded to desire the prayers of the faithful for himself. And this
he generally does in the conclusions of his Epistles; yet not without
making a difference. For he speaks in one manner to them whom he treats
as his children, with the gravity or even severity of a father, such as
Timothy, Titus, the Corinthians, and Galatians; in another, to them whom
he treats rather like equals, such as the Romans, Ephesians,
Thessalonians, Colossians, Hebrews.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p28">31. That I may be delivered - He is thus urgent from a
sense of the importance of his life to the church. Otherwise he would
have rejoiced "to depart, and to be with Christ." And that my service
may be acceptable - In spite of all their prejudices; to the end the
Jewish and gentile believers may be knit together in tender love.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvi-p29">32. That I may come to you - This refers to the former,
With joy - To the latter, part of the preceding verse.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="15.04%" prev="i.vii.xvi" next="i.viii" id="i.vii.xvii">
<h3 id="i.vii.xvii-p0.1">XVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Romans XVI" id="i.vii.xvii-p0.2" parsed="|Rom|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.16" /> 

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p1">1. I commend unto you Phebe - The bearer of this letter. A
servant - The Greek word is a deaconness. Of the church in Cenchrea - In
the apostolic age, some grave and pious women were appointed
deaconnesses in every church. It was their office, not to teach
publicly, but to visit the sick, the women in particular, and to
minister to them both in their temporal and spiritual necessities.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p2">2. In the Lord - That is, for the Lord's sake, and in a
Christian manner. St. Paul seems fond of this expression.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p3">4. Who have for my life, as it were, laid down their own
necks - That is, exposed themselves to the utmost danger. But likewise
all the churches of the gentiles - Even that at Rome, for preserving so
valuable a life.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p4">5. Salute the church that is in their house - Aquila had
been driven from Rome in the reign of Claudius, but was now returned,
and performed the same part there which Caius did at Corinth, ver. 23.
Where any Christian had a large house, there they all assembled together
though as yet the Christians at Rome had neither bishops nor deacons. So
far were they from any shadow of papal power. Nay, there does not appear
to have been then in the whole city any more than one of these domestic
churches. Otherwise there can be no doubt but St. Paul would have
saluted them also. Epenetus - Although the apostle had never been at
Rome, yet had he many acquaintance there. But here is no mention of
Linus or Cemens; whence it appears, they did not come to Rome till after
this. The firstfruits of Asia - The first convert in the proconsular
Asia.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p5">7. Who are of note among the apostles - They seem to have
been some of the most early converts. Fellowprisoners - For the gospel's
sake.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p6">9. Our fellowlabourer - Mine and Timothy's, verse 21.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p7">11. Those of the family of Aristobulus and Narcissus, who
are in the Lord - It seems only part of their families were converted.
Probably, some of them were not known to St. Paul by face, but only by
character. Faith does not create moroseness, but courtesy, which even
the gravity of an apostle did not hinder.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p8">12. Salute Tryphena and Tryphosa - Probably they were two
sisters.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p9">13. Salute Rufus - Perhaps the same that is mentioned, <scripRef passage="Mark xv. 21" id="i.vii.xvii-p9.1" parsed="|Mark|15|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.15.21">Mark xv, 21</scripRef>. And his mother and mine - This expression may only denote
the tender care which Rufus's mother had taken of him.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p10">14. Salute Asyncritus, Phlegon, &amp;c. - He seems to join
those together, who were joined by kindred, nearness of habitation, or
any other circumstance. It could not but encourage the poor especially,
to be saluted by name, who perhaps did not know that the apostle bad
ever heard of them. It is observable, that whilst the apostle forgets
none who are worthy, yet he adjusts the nature of his salutation to the
degrees of worth in those whom he salutes.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p11">15. Salute all the saints - Had St. Peter been then at
Rome, St. Paul would doubtless have saluted him by name; since no one in
this numerous catalogue was of an eminence comparable to his. But if he
was not then at Rome, the whole Roman tradition, with regard to the
succession of their bishops, fails in the most fundamental article.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p12">16. Salute one another with an holy kiss - Termed by St.
Peter, "the kiss of love," <scripRef passage="1 Pet. v. 14" id="i.vii.xvii-p12.1" parsed="|1Pet|5|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.5.14">1 Pet. v,
14</scripRef>. So the ancient Christians concluded all their solemn
offices; the men saluting the men, and the women the women. And this
apostolical custom seems to have continued for some ages in all
Christian churches.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p13">17. Mark them who cause divisions - Such there were,
therefore, at Rome also. Avoid them - Avoid all unnecessary intercourse
with them.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p14">18. By good words - Concerning themselves, making great
promises. And fair speeches - Concerning you, praising and flattering
you. The harmless - Who, doing no ill themselves, are not upon their
guard against them that do.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p15">19. But I would have you - Not only obedient, but discreet
also. Wise with regard to that which is good - As knowing in this as
possible. And simple with regard to that which is evil - As ignorant of
this as possible.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p16">20. And the God of peace - The Author and Lover of it,
giving a blessing to your discretion. Shall bruise Satan under your feet
- Shall defeat all the artifices of that sower of tares, and unite you
more and more together in love.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p17">21. Timotheus my fellowlabourer - Here he is named even
before St. Paul's kinsmen. But as he had never been at Rome, he is not
named in the beginning of the epistle.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p18">22. I Tertius, who wrote this epistle, salute you -
Tertius, who wrote what the apostle dictated, inserted this, either by
St. Paul's exhortation or ready permission. Caius - The Corinthian, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. i. 14" id="i.vii.xvii-p18.1" parsed="|1Cor|1|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.1.14">1 Cor. i, 14</scripRef>. My host, and of the whole church - Who probably met for
some time in his house.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p19">23. The chamberlain of the city - Of Corinth.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p20">25. Now to him who is able - The last words of this epistle
exactly answer the first, chapter i, 1-v, chap. i, 1-v, in particular,
concerning the power of God, the gospel, Jesus Christ, the scriptures,
the obedience of faith, all nations. To establish you - Both Jews and
gentiles. According to my gospel, and the preaching of Jesus Christ -
That is, according to the tenor of the gospel of Jesus Christ, which I
preach. According to the Revelation of the mystery - Of the calling of
the gentiles, which, as plainly as it was foretold in the Prophets, was
still hid from many even of the believing Jews.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p21">26. According to the commandment - The foundation of the
apostolical office. Of the eternal God - A more proper epithet could not
be. A new dispensation infers no change in God. Known unto him are all
his works, and every variation of them, from eternity. Made known to all
nations - Not barely that they might know, but enjoy it also, through
obeying the faith.</p>

<p id="i.vii.xvii-p22">27. To the only wise God - Whose manifold wisdom is known
in the church through the gospel, <scripRef passage="Eph. iii. 10" id="i.vii.xvii-p22.1" parsed="|Eph|3|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.3.10">Eph.
iii, 10</scripRef>. "To him who is able," and, to the wise God," are joined, as
<scripRef passage="1 Cor. i. 24" id="i.vii.xvii-p22.2" parsed="|1Cor|1|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.1.24">1 Cor. i, 24</scripRef>, where Christ is styled "the wisdom of God," and "the power
of God." To him be glory through Christ Jesus forever - And let every
believer say, Amen!</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S FIRST EPISTLE TO THE CORINTHIANS" progress="15.15%" prev="i.vii.xvii" next="i.viii.i" id="i.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1Cor" id="i.viii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.viii-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S FIRST EPISTLE TO THE CORINTHIANS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to First Corinthinas" progress="15.15%" prev="i.viii" next="i.viii.ii" id="i.viii.i">

<p id="i.viii.i-p1">CORINTH was a city of Achaia, situate on the isthmus which
joins Peloponnesus, now called the Morea, to the rest of Greece. Being
so advantageously situated for trade, the inhabitants of it abounded in
riches, which, by too natural a consequence, led them into luxury,
lewdness, and all manner of vice. Yet even here St. Paul planted a
numerous church, chiefly of heathen converts; to whom, about three years
after he had left Corinth, he wrote this epistle from Ephesus; as well
to correct various disorders of which they were guilty, as to answer
some questions which they had proposed to him. The Epistle consists of:
The inscription Chap. i. 1-3</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.viii.i-p2">I. The treatise itself, in which is,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.viii.i-p3">1. An exhortation to concord, beating down
all glorying in the flesh, 4- iv.21</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.viii.i-p4">2. A reproof,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p5">1. For not excommunicating the incestuous
person, v. 1-13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p6">2. For going to law before heathen Judges,
vi. 1-11</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p7">3. A dissuasive from fornication, 12-20</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p8">4. An answer to the questions they had
proposed concerning marriage, vii. 1, 10, 25, 36, 39</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p9">5. Concerning things sacrificed to idols,
viii. 1- ix. 1</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p10">6. Concerning the veiling of women, 2-16</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p11">7. Concerning the Lord's supper, 17-34</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p12">8. Concerning spiritual gifts, xii. xiii.
xiv</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p13">9. Concerning the resurrection, xv. 1-58</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.i-p14">10. Concerning the collection for the poor,
the coming of himself, of Timothy, of Apollos, the sum of all, xvi, 1,
5, 10, 12, 13, 14</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.viii.i-p15">II. The conclusion, 15, 17, 19-24</p>
<h2 id="i.viii.i-p15.1">1st CORINTHIANS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="15.17%" prev="i.viii.i" next="i.viii.iii" id="i.viii.ii">
<h3 id="i.viii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. I" id="i.viii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.1" /> 

<p id="i.viii.ii-p1">1. Paul, called to be an apostle - There is great propriety
in every clause of the salutation, particularly in this, as there were
some in the church of Corinth who called the authority of his mission in
question. Through the will of God - Called "the commandment of God," <scripRef passage="1 Tim. i. 1" id="i.viii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|1Tim|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.1.1">1 Tim. i, 1</scripRef> This was to the churches the ground of his authority; to
Paul himself, of an humble and ready mind. By the mention of God, the
authority of man is excluded, <scripRef passage="Gal. i. 1" id="i.viii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Gal|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.1.1">Gal. i, 1</scripRef>; by the mention of the will of God, the merit of Paul, chap.
xv, 8, &amp;c. And Sosthenes - A Corinthian, St. Paul's companion in
travel. It was both humility and prudence in the apostle, thus to join
his name with his own, in an epistle wherein he was to reprove so many
irregularities. Sosthenes the brother - Probably this word is
emphatical; as if he had said, Who, from a Jewish opposer of the gospel,
became a faithful brother.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p2">2. To the church of God which is in Corinth - St. Paul,
writing in a familiar manner to the Corinthians, as also to the
Thessalonians and Galatians, uses this plain appellation. To the other
churches he uses a more solemn address. Sanctified through Jesus Christ
- And so undoubtedly they were in general, notwithstanding some
exceptions. Called - Of Jesus Christ, <scripRef passage="Rom. i. 6" id="i.viii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Rom|1|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.1.6">Rom.
i, 6</scripRef> And - As the fruit of that calling made holy. With all that
in every place - Nothing could better suit that catholic love which St.
Paul labours to promote in this epistle, than such a declaration of his
good wishes for every true Christian upon earth. Call upon the name of
our Lord Jesus Christ - This plainly implies that all Christians pray to
Christ, as well as to the Father through him.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p3">4. Always - Whenever I mention you to God in prayer.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p4">5. In all utterance and knowledge - Of divine things. These
gifts the Corinthians particularly admired. Therefore this
congratulation naturally tended to soften their spirits, and I make way
for the reproofs which follow.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p5">6. The testimony of Christ - The gospel. Was confirmed
among you - By these gifts attending it. They knew they had received
these by the hand of Paul: and this consideration was highly proper, to
revive in them their former reverence and affection for their spiritual
father.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p6">7. Waiting - With earnest desire. For the glorious
Revelation of our Lord Jesus Christ - A sure mark of a true or false
Christian, to long for, or dread, this Revelation.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p7">8. Who will also - if you faithfully apply to him. Confirm
you to the end. In the day of Christ - Now it is our day, wherein we are
to work out our salvation; then it will be eminently the day of Christ,
and of his glory in the saints.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p8">9. God is faithful - To all his promises; and therefore "to
him that hath shall be given." By whom ye are called - A pledge of his
willingness to save you unto the uttermost.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p9">10. Now I exhort you - Ye have faith and hope; secure love
also. By the endearing name of our Lord Jesus Christ - lnfinitely
preferable to all the human names in which ye glory. That ye all speak
the same thing - They now spoke different things, ver. 12 And that there
be no schisms among you - No alienation of affection from each other. Is
this word ever taken in any other sense in scripture? But that ye be
joined in the same mind - Affections, desires. And judgment - Touching
all the grand truths of the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p10">11. It hath been declared to me by them of the family of
Chloe - Whom some suppose to have been the wife of Stephanas, and the
mother of Fortunatus and Achaicus. By these three the Corinthians had
sent their letter to St. Paul, chap. xvi, 17. That there are contentions
- A word equivalent with schisms in the preceding verse.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p11">12. Now this I say - That is, what I mean is this: there
are various parties among you, who set themselves, one against an other,
in behalf of the several teachers they admire. And I of Christ - They
spoke well, if they had not on this pretense despised their teachers,
chap. iv, 8 Perhaps they valued themselves on having heard Christ preach
in his own person.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p12">13. Is Christ divided - Are not all the members still under
one head? Was not he alone crucified for you all; and were ye not all
baptized in his name? The glory of Christ then is not to be divided
between him and his servants; neither is the unity of the body to be
torn asunder, seeing Christ is one still.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p13">14. I thank God - (A pious phrase for the common one, "I
rejoice,") that, in the course of his providence, I baptized none of
you, but Crispus, once the ruler of the synagogue, and Caius.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p14">15. Lest any should say that I had baptized in my own name
- In order to attach them to myself.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p15">16. I know not - That is, it does not at present occur to
my memory, that I baptized any other.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p16">17. For God did not send me to baptize - That was not my
chief errand: those of inferior rank and abilities could do it: though
all the apostles were sent to baptize also, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxviii. 19" id="i.viii.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|28|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.28.19">Matt. xxviii, 19</scripRef> But to preach the gospel - So the apostle slides into his
general proposition: but not with wisdom of speech - With the artificial
ornaments of discourse, invented by human wisdom. Lest the cross of
Christ should be made of none effect - The whole effect of St. Paul's
preaching was owing to the power of God accompanying the plain
declaration of that great truth, "Christ bore our sins upon the cross."
But this effect might have been imputed to another cause, had he come
with that wisdom of speech which they admired.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p17">18. To them that perish - By obstinately rejecting the only
name whereby they can be saved. But to us who are saved - Now saved from
our sins, and in the way to everlasting salvation, it is the great
instrument of the power of God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p18">19. For it is written - And the words are remarkably
applicable to this great event. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxix. 14" id="i.viii.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Isa|29|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.29.14">Isaiah xxix, 14</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p19">20. Where is the wise? &amp;c. - The deliverance of Judea
from Sennacherib is what Isaiah refers to in these words; in a bold and
beautiful allusion to which, the apostle in the clause that follows
triumphs over all the opposition of human wisdom to the victorious
gospel of Christ. What could the wise men of the gentiles do against
this? or the Jewish scribes? or the disputers of this world? - Those
among both, who, proud of their acuteness, were fond of controversy, and
thought they could confute all opponents. Hath not God made foolish the
wisdom of this world - That is, shown it to be very foolishness. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxxiii. 18" id="i.viii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Isa|33|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.33.18">Isaiah xxxiii, 18</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p20">21. For since in the wisdom of God - According to his wise
disposals, leaving them to make the trial. The world - Whether Jewish or
gentile, by all its boasted wisdom knew not God - Though the whole
creation declared its Creator, and though he declared himself by all the
prophets; it pleased God, by a way which those who perish count mere
foolishness, to save them that believe.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p21">22. For whereas the Jews demand of the apostles, as they
did of their Lord, more signs still, after all they have seen already;
and the Greeks, or gentiles, seek wisdom - The depths of philosophy, and
the charms of eloquence.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p22">23. We go on to preach, in a plain and historical, not
rhetorical or philosophical, manner, Christ crucified, to the Jews a
stumblingblock - Just opposite to the "signs" they demand. And to the
Greeks foolishness - A silly tale, just opposite to the wisdom they
seek.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p23">24. But to them that are called - And obey the heavenly
calling. Christ - With his cross, his death, his life, his kingdom. And
they experience, first, that he is the power, then, that he is the
wisdom, of God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p24">25. Because the foolishness of God - The gospel scheme,
which the world judge to be mere foolishness, is wiser than the wisdom
of men; and, weak as they account it, stronger than all the strength of
men.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p25">26. Behold your calling - What manner of men they are whom
God calls. That not many wise men after the flesh - In the account of
the world. Not many mighty - Men of power and authority.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p26">28. Things that are not - The Jews frequently called the
gentiles, "Them that are not," <scripRef passage="2 Esdras vi. 56, 57" id="i.viii.ii-p26.1" parsed="|2Esd|6|56|6|57" osisRef="Bible:2Esd.6.56-2Esd.6.57">2 Esdras vi. 56, 57</scripRef>. In so supreme
contempt did they hold them. The things that are - In high esteem.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p27">29. That no flesh - A fit appellation. Flesh is fair, but
withering as grass. May glory before God - In God we ought to glory.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p28">30. Of him - Out of his free grace and mercy. Are ye
Engrafted into Christ Jesus, who is made unto us that believe wisdom,
who were before utterly foolish and ignorant. Righteousness - The sole
ground of our justification, who were before under the wrath and curse
of God. Sanctification - A principle of universal holiness, whereas
before we were altogether dead in sin. And redemption - That is,
complete deliverance from all evil, and eternal bliss both of soul and
body.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ii-p29">31. Let him glory in the Lord - Not in himself, not in the
flesh, not in the world. <scripRef passage="Jer. ix. 23, 24" id="i.viii.ii-p29.1" parsed="|Jer|9|23|9|24" osisRef="Bible:Jer.9.23-Jer.9.24">Jer. ix,
23, 24</scripRef></p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="15.33%" prev="i.viii.ii" next="i.viii.iv" id="i.viii.iii">
<h3 id="i.viii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. II" id="i.viii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.2" /> 

<p id="i.viii.iii-p1">1. And I accordingly came to you, not with loftiness of
speech or of wisdom - I did not affect either deep wisdom or eloquence.
Declaring the testimony of God - What God gave me to testify concerning
his Son.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p2">2. I determined not to know anything - To wave all my other
knowledge, and not to preach anything, save Jesus Christ, and him
crucified - That is, what he did, suffered, taught. A part is put for
the whole.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p3">3. And I was with you - At my first entrance. In weakness -
Of body, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. xii. 7" id="i.viii.iii-p3.1" parsed="|2Cor|12|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.12.7">2 Cor. xii, 7</scripRef> And in fear - Lest I should offend any. And in much
trembling - The emotion of my mind affecting my very body.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p4">4. And my speech in private, as well as my public
preaching, was not with the persuasive words of human wisdom, such as
the wise men of the world use; but with the demonstration of the Spirit
and of power - With that powerful kind of demonstration, which flows
from the Holy Spirit; which works on the conscience with the most
convincing light, and the most persuasive evidence.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p5">5. That your faith might not be built on the wisdom or
power of man, but on the wisdom and power of God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p6">6. Yet we speak wisdom - Yea, the truest and most excellent
wisdom. Among the perfect - Adult, experienced Christians. By wisdom
here he seems to mean, not the whole Christian doctrine, but the most
sublime and abstruse parts of it. But not the wisdom admired and taught
by the men of this world, nor of the rulers of this world, Jewish or
heathen, that come to nought - Both they and their wisdom, and the world
itself.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p7">7. But we speak the mysterious wisdom of God, which was
hidden for many ages from all the world, and is still hidden even from
"babes in Christ;" much more from all unbelievers. Which God ordained
before the world - So far is this from coming to nought, like worldly
wisdom. For our glory - Arising from the glory of our Lord, and then to
be revealed when all worldly glory vanishes.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p8">8. Had they known it - That wisdom. They would not have
crucified - Punished as a slave. The Lord of glory - The giving Christ
this august title, peculiar to the great Jehovah, plainly shows him to
be the supreme God. In like manner the Father is styled, "the Father of
glory," <scripRef passage="Eph. i. 17" id="i.viii.iii-p8.1" parsed="|Eph|1|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.1.17">Eph. i, 17</scripRef>; and the Holy Ghost, "the Spirit of glory," <scripRef passage="1 Pet. iv. 14" id="i.viii.iii-p8.2" parsed="|1Pet|4|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.4.14">1
Pet. iv, 14</scripRef>. The application of this title to all the three, shows that
the Father, Son, and Holy Ghost are "the God of glory;" as the only true
God is called, <scripRef passage="Psalm xxix. 3" id="i.viii.iii-p8.3" parsed="|Ps|29|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.29.3">Psalm
xxix, 3</scripRef>, and <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 2" id="i.viii.iii-p8.4" parsed="|Acts|7|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.2">Acts vii, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p9">9. But this ignorance of theirs fulfils what is written
concerning the blessings of the Messiah's kingdom. No natural man hath
either seen, heard, or known, the things which God hath prepared, saith
the prophet, for them that love him. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxiv. 4" id="i.viii.iii-p9.1" parsed="|Isa|64|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.64.4">Isaiah lxiv, 4</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p10">10. But God hath revealed - Yea, and "freely given," ver.
12. Them to us - Even inconceivable peace, and joy unspeakable. By his
Spirit - Who intimately and fully knows them. For the Spirit searcheth
even the deep things of God - Be they ever so hidden and mysterious; the
depths both of his nature and his kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p11">11. For what man knoweth the things of a man - All the
inmost recesses of his mind; although men are all of one nature, and so
may the more easily know one another. So the things of God knoweth no
one but the Spirit - Who, consequently, is God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p12">12. Now we have received, not the spirit of the world -
This spirit is not properly received; for the men of the world always
had it. But Christians receive the Spirit of God, which before they had
not.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p13">13. Which also we speak - As well as know. In words taught
by the Holy Spirit - Such are all the words of scripture. How high a
regard ought we, then, to retain for them! Explaining spiritual things
by spiritual words; or, adapting spiritual words to spiritual things -
Being taught of the Spirit to express the things of the Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p14">14. But the natural man - That is, every man who hath not
the Spirit; who has no other way of obtaining knowledge, but by his
senses and natural understanding. Receiveth not - Does not understand or
conceive. The things of the Spirit - The things revealed by the Spirit
of God, whether relating to his nature or his kingdom. For they are
foolishness to him - He is so far from understanding, that he utterly
despises, them Neither can he know them - As he has not the will, so
neither has he the power. Because they are spiritually discerned - They
can only be discerned by the aid of that Spirit, and by those spiritual
senses, which he has not.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p15">15. But the spiritual man - He that hath the Spirit.
Discerneth all the things of God whereof we have been speaking. Yet he
himself is discerned by no man - No natural men. They neither understand
what he is, nor what he says.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iii-p16">16. Who - What natural man. We - Spiritual men; apostles in
particular. Have - Know, understand. The mind of Christ - Concerning the
whole plan of gospel salvation. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 13" id="i.viii.iii-p16.1" parsed="|Isa|40|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.13">Isaiah
xl, 13</scripRef></p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="15.41%" prev="i.viii.iii" next="i.viii.v" id="i.viii.iv">
<h3 id="i.viii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. III" id="i.viii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.3" /> 

<p id="i.viii.iv-p1">1. And I, brethren -- he spoke before, ver. 1, of his
entrance, now of his progress, among them. Could not speak to you as
unto spiritual - Adult, experienced Christians. But as unto men who were
still in great measure carnal, as unto babes in Christ - Still weak in
grace, though eminent in gifts, chap. i, 5.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p2">2. I fed you, as babes, with milk - The first and plainest
truths of the gospel. So should every preacher suit his doctrine to his
hearers.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p3">3. For while there is among you emulation in your hearts,
strife in your words, and actual divisions, are ye not carnal, and walk
according to men - As mere men; not as Christians, according to God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p4">4. I am of Apollos - St. Paul named himself and Apollos, to
show that he would condemn any division among them, even though it were
in favour of himself, or the dearest friend he had in the world. Are ye
not carnal - For the Spirit of God allows no party zeal.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p5">5. Ministers - Or servants. By whom ye believed, as the
Lord, the Master of those servants, gave to every man.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p6">7. God that giveth the increase - Is all in all: without
him neither planting nor watering avails.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p7">8. But he that planteth and he that watereth are one -
Which is another argument against division. Though their labours are
different. they are all employed in one general work, - the saving
souls. Hence he takes occasion to speak of the reward of them that
labour faithfully, and the awful account to be given by all. Every man
shall receive his own peculiar reward according to his own peculiar
labour - Not according to his success; but he who labours much, though
with small success, shall have a great reward. Has not all this
reasoning the same force still? The ministers are still surely
instruments in God's hand, and depend as entirely as ever on his
blessing, to give the increase to their labours. Without this, they are
nothing: with it, their part is so small, that they hardly deserve to be
mentioned. May their hearts and hands be more united; and, retaining a
due sense of the honour God doeth them in employing them, may they
faithfully labour, not as for themselves, but for the great Proprietor
of all, till the day come when he will reward them in full proportion to
their fidelity and diligence!</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p8">9. For we are all fellowlabourers - God's labourers, and
fellowlabourers with each other. Ye are God's husbandry - This is the
sum of what went before: it is a comprehensive word, taking in both a
field, a garden, and a vineyard. Ye are God's building - This is the sum
of what follows.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p9">10. According to the grace of God given to me - This he
premises, lest he should seem to ascribe it to himself. Let every one
take heed how he buildeth thereon - That all his doctrines may be
consistent with the foundation.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p10">11. For other foundation - On which the whole church: and
all its doctrines, duties, and blessings may be built. Can no man lay
than what is laid - In the counsels of divine wisdom, in the promises
and prophecies of the Old Testament, in the preaching of the apostles,
St. Paul in particular. Which is Jesus Christ - Who, in his person and
offices, is the firm, immovable Rock of Ages, every way sufficient to
bear all the weight that God himself, or the sinner, when he believes,
can lay upon him.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p11">12. If any one build gold, silver, costly stones - Three
sorts of materials which will bear the fire; true and solid doctrines.
Wood, hay, stubble - Three which will not bear the fire. Such are all
doctrines, ceremonies, and forms of human invention; all but the
substantial, vital truths of Christianity.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p12">13. The time is coming when every one's work shall be made
manifest: for the day of the Lord, that great and final day, shall
declare it - To all the world. For it is revealed - What faith beholds
as so certain and so near is spoken of as already present. By fire; yea,
the fire shall try every one's work, of what sort it is - The strict
process of that day will try every man's doctrines, whether they come up
to the scripture standard or not. Here is a plain allusion to the
flaming light and consuming heat of the general conflagration. But the
expression, when applied to the trying of doctrines, and consuming those
that are wrong, is evidently figurative; because no material fire can
have such an effect on what is of a moral nature. And therefore it is
added, he who builds wood, hay, or stubble, shall be saved as through
the fire - Or, as narrowly as a man escapes through the fire, when his
house is all in flames about him. This text, then, is so far from
establishing the Romanish purgatory, that it utterly overthrows it. For
the fire here mentioned does not exist till the day of judgment:
therefore, if this be the fire of purgatory, it follows that purgatory
does not exist before the day of judgment.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p13">14. He shall receive a reward - A peculiar degree of glory.
Some degree even the other will receive, seeing he held the foundation;
though through ignorance he built thereon what would not abide the
fire.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p14">15. He shall suffer loss - The loss of that peculiar degree
of glory.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p15">16. Ye - All Christians. Are the temple of God - The most
noble kind of building, ver. 9.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p16">17. If any man destroy the temple of God - Destroy a real
Christian, by schisms, or doctrines fundamentally wrong. Him shall God
destroy - He shall not be saved at all; not even as through the
fire."</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p17">18. Let him become a fool in this world - Such as the world
accounts so. That he may become wise - In God's account.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p18">19. For all the boasted wisdom of the world is mere
foolishness in the sight of God. He taketh the wise in their own
craftiness - Not only while they think they are acting wisely, but by
their very wisdom, which itself is their snare, and the occasion of
their destruction. <scripRef passage="Job v. 13" id="i.viii.iv-p18.1" parsed="|Job|5|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.5.13">Job v,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p19">20. That they are but vain - Empty, foolish; they and all
their thoughts. <scripRef passage="Psalm xciv. 11" id="i.viii.iv-p19.1" parsed="|Ps|94|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.94.11">Psalm xciv,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p20">21. Therefore - Upon the whole. Let none glory in men - So
as to divide into parties on their account. For all things are yours -
and we in particular. We are not your lords, but rather your
servants.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p21">22. Whether Paul or Apollos, or Cephas - We are all equally
yours, to serve you for Christ's sake. Or the world - This leap from
Peter to the world greatly enlarges the thought, and argues a kind of
impatience of enumerating the rest. Peter and every one in the whole
world, however excellent in gifts, or grace, or office, are also your
servants for Christ's sake. Or life, or death - These, with all their
various circumstances, are disposed as will be most for your advantage.
Or things present - On earth. Or things to come - In heaven. Contend,
therefore, no more about these little things; but be ye united in love,
as ye are in blessings.</p>

<p id="i.viii.iv-p22">23. And ye are Christ's - His property, his subjects. his
members. And Christ is God's - As Mediator, he refers all his services
to his Father's glory.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="15.53%" prev="i.viii.iv" next="i.viii.vi" id="i.viii.v">
<h3 id="i.viii.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. IV" id="i.viii.v-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.4" /> 

<p id="i.viii.v-p1">1. Let a man account us, as servants of Christ - The
original word properly signifies such servants as laboured at the oar in
rowing vessels; and, accordingly, intimates the pains which every
faithful minister takes in his Lord's work. O God, where are these
ministers to be found? Lord, thou knowest. And stewards of the mysteries
of God - Dispenseth of the mysterious truths of the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p2">3. Yea, I judge not myself - My final state is not to be
determined by my own judgment.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p3">4. I am not conscious to myself of anything evil; yet am I
not hereby justified - I depend not on this, as a sufficient
justification of myself in God's account. But he that judgeth me is the
Lord - By his sentence I am to stand or fall.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p4">5. Therefore judge nothing before the time - Appointed for
judging all men. Until the Lord come, who, in order to pass a righteous
judgment, which otherwise would be impossible, will both bring to light
the things which are now covered with impenetrable darkness, and
manifest the most secret springs of action, the principles and
intentions of every heart. And then shall every one - Every faithful
steward, have praise of God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p5">6. These things - Mentioned, chap. i, 10, &amp;c. I have by
a very obvious figure transferred to myself and Apollos - And Cephas,
instead of naming those particular preachers at Corinth, to whom ye are
so fondly attached. That ye may learn by us - From what has been said
concerning us, who, however eminent we are, are mere instruments in
God's hand. Not to think of any man above what is here written - Or
above what scripture warrants. chap. iii, 7</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p6">7. Who maketh thee to differ - Either in gifts or graces.
As if thou hadst not received it - As if thou hadst it originally from
thyself.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p7">8. Now ye are full - The Corinthians abounded with
spiritual gifts; and so did the apostles: but the apostles, by continual
want and sufferings, were kept from self- complacency. The Corinthians
suffering nothing, and having plenty of all things, were pleased with
and applauded themselves; and they were like children who, being raised
in the world, disregard their poor parents. Now ye are full, says the
apostle, in a beautiful gradation, ye are rich, ye have reigned as kings
- A proverbial expression, denoting the most splendid and plentiful
circumstances. Without any thought of us. And I would ye did reign - In
the best sense: I would ye had attained the height of holiness. That we
might reign with you - Having no more sorrow on your account, but
sharing in your happiness.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p8">9. God hath set forth us last, as appointed to death -
Alluding to the Roman custom of bringing forth those persons last on the
stage, either to fight with each other, or with wild beasts, who were
devoted to death; so that, if they escaped one day, they were brought
out again and again, till they were killed.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p9">10. We are fools, in the account of the world, for Christ's
sake, but ye are wise in Christ - Though ye are Christians, ye think
yourselves wise; and ye have found means to make the world think you so
too. We are weak - In presence, in infirmities, in sufferings. But ye
are strong - In just opposite circumstances.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p10">11. And are naked - Who can imagine a more glorious triumph
of the truth, than that which is gained in these circumstances when St.
Paul, with an impediment in his speech, and a person rather contemptible
than graceful, appeared in a mean, perhaps tattered, dress before
persons of the highest distinction, and yet commanded such attention.
and made such deep impressions upon them!</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p11">12. We bless-suffer it-intreat - We do not return
revilings, persecution, defamation; nothing but blessing.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p12">13. We are made as the filth of the world, and offscouring
of all things - Such were those poor wretches among the heathens, who
were taken from the dregs of the people, to be offered as expiatory
sacrifices to the infernal gods. They were loaded with curses, affronts,
and injuries, all the way they went to the altars; and when the ashes of
those unhappy men were thrown into the sea, these very names were given
them in the ceremony.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p13">14. I do not write these things to shame you, but as my
beloved children I warn you - It is with admirable prudence and
sweetness the apostle adds this, to prevent any unkind construction of
his words.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p14">15. I have begotten you - This excludes not only Apollos,
his successor, but also Silas and Timothy, his companions; and the
relation between a spiritual father and his children brings with it an
inexpressible nearness and affection.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p15">16. Be ye followers of me - In that spirit and behaviour
which I have so largely declared.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p16">17. My beloved son - Elsewhere he styles him "brother," <scripRef passage="2 Cor. i. 1" id="i.viii.v-p16.1" parsed="|2Cor|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.1.1">2 Cor. i, 1</scripRef>; but here paternal affection takes place. As I teach - No
less by example than precept.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p17">18. Now some are puffed up - St. Paul saw, by a divine
light, the thoughts which would arise in their hearts. As if I would not
come - Because I send Timothy.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p18">19. I will know - He here shows his fatherly authority Not
the big, empty speech of these vain boasters, but how much of the power
of God attends them.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p19">20. For the kingdom of God - Real religion, does not
consist in words, but in the power of God ruling the heart.</p>

<p id="i.viii.v-p20">21. With a rod - That is, with severity.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="15.63%" prev="i.viii.v" next="i.viii.vii" id="i.viii.vi">
<h3 id="i.viii.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. V" id="i.viii.vi-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.5" /> 

<p id="i.viii.vi-p1">1. Fornication - The original word implies criminal
conversation of any kind whatever. His father's wife - While his father
was alive.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p2">2. Are ye puffed up? Should ye not rather have mourned -
Have solemnly humbled yourselves, and at that time of solemn mourning
have expelled that notorious sinner from your communion?</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p3">3. I verily, as present in spirit - Having a full (it
seems, a miraculous) view of the whole fact. Have already, as if I were
actually present, judged him who hath so scandalously done this.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p4">4. And my spirit - Present with you. With the power of the
Lord Jesus Christ - To confirm my sentence.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p5">5. To deliver such an one - This was the highest degree of
punishment in the Christian church; and we may observe, the passing this
sentence was the act of the apostle, not of the Corinthians. To Satan -
Who was usually permitted, in such cases, to inflict pain or sickness on
the offender. For the destruction - Though slowly and gradually. Of the
flesh - Unless prevented by speedy repentance.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p6">6. Your glorying - Either in your gifts or prosperity, at
such a time as this, is not good. Know ye not that a little leaven - One
sin, or one sinner. Leaveneth the whole lump - Diffuses guilt and
infection through the whole congregation.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p7">7. Purge out therefore the old leaven - Both of sinners and
of sin. That ye may be a new lump, as ye are unleavened - That is, that
being unleavened ye may be a new lump, holy unto the Lord. For our
passover is slain for us - The Jewish passover, about the time of which
this epistle was wrote, ver. 11, was only a type of this. What exquisite
skill both here and everywhere conducts the zeal of the inspired writer!
How surprising a transition is here, and yet how perfectly natural! The
apostle, speaking of the incestuous criminal, slides into his darling
topic, - crucified saviour. Who would have expected it on such an
occasion. Yet, when it is thus brought in, who does not see and admire
both the propriety of the subject, and the delicacy of its
introduction?</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p8">8. Therefore let us keep the feast - Let us feed on him by
faith. Here is a plain allusion to the Lord's supper, which was
instituted in the room of the passover. Not with the old leaven - Of
heathenism or Judaism. Malignity is stubbornness in evil. Sincerity and
truth seem to be put here for the whole of true, inward religion.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p9">9. I wrote to you in a former epistle - And, doubtless,
both St. Paul and the other apostles wrote many things which are not
extant now. Not to converse - Familiarly; not to contract any intimacy
or acquaintance with them, more than is absolutely necessary.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p10">10. But I did not mean that you should altogether refrain
from conversing with heathens, though they are guilty in some of these
respects. Covetous, rapacious, idolaters - Sinners against themselves,
their neighbour, God. For then ye must go out of the world - Then all
civil commerce must cease. So that going out of the world, which some
account a perfection, St. Paul accounts an utter absurdity.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p11">11. Who is named a brother - That is, a Christian;
especially if a member of the same congregation. Rapacious - Guilty of
oppression, extortion, or any open injustice. No, not to eat with him -
Which is the lowest degree of familiarity.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p12">12. I speak of Christians only. For what have I to do to
judge heathens? But ye, as well as I, judge those of your own
community.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vi-p13">13. Them that are without God will judge - The passing
sentence on these he hath reserved to himself. And ye will take away
that wicked person - This properly belongs to you.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="15.69%" prev="i.viii.vi" next="i.viii.viii" id="i.viii.vii">
<h3 id="i.viii.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. VI" id="i.viii.vii-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.6" /> 

<p id="i.viii.vii-p1">1. The unjust - The heathens. A Christian could expect no
justice from these. The saints - Who might easily decide these smaller
differences in a private and friendly manner.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p2">2. Know ye not - This expression occurs six times in this
single chapter, and that with a peculiar force; for the Corinthians knew
and gloried in it, but they did not practice. That the saints - After
having been judged themselves. Shall judge the world - Shall be
assessors with Christ in the judgment wherein he shall condemn all the
wicked, as well angels as men, <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 28" id="i.viii.vii-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|19|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.28">Matt.
xix, 28</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Rev. xx. 4" id="i.viii.vii-p2.2" parsed="|Rev|20|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.20.4">Rev. xx,
4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p3">4. Them who are of no esteem in the church - That is,
heathens, who, as such, could be in no esteem with the Christians.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p4">5. Is there not one among you, who are such admirers of
wisdom, that is wise enough to decide such causes?</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p5">7. Indeed there is a fault, that ye quarrel with each other
at all, whether ye go to law or no. Why do ye not rather suffer wrong -
All men cannot or will not receive this saying. Many aim only at this,
"I will neither do wrong, nor suffer it." These are honest heathens, but
no Christians.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p6">8. Nay, ye do wrong - Openly. And defraud - Privately. O
how powerfully did the mystery of iniquity already work!</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p7">9. Idolatry is here placed between fornication and
adultery, because they generally accompanied it. Nor the effeminate -
Who live in an easy, indolent way; taking up no cross, enduring no
hardship. But how is this? These good-natured, harmless people are
ranked with idolaters and sodomites! We may learn hence, that we are
never secure from the greatest sins, till we guard against those which
are thought the least; nor, indeed, till we think no sin is little,
since every one is a step toward hell.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p8">11. And such were some of you: but ye are washed - From
those gross abominations; nay, and ye are inwardly sanctified; not
before, but in consequence of, your being justified in the name - That
is, by the merits, of the Lord Jesus, through which your sins are
forgiven. And by the Spirit of our God - By whom ye are thus washed and
sanctified.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p9">12. All things - Which are lawful for you. Are lawful for
me, but all things are not always expedient - Particularly when anything
would offend my weak brother; or when it would enslave my own soul. For
though all things are lawful for me, yet I will not be brought under the
power of any - So as to be uneasy when I abstain from it; for, if so,
then I am under the power of it.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p10">13. As if he had said, I speak this chiefly with regard to
meats; (and would to God all Christians would consider it!) particularly
with regard to those offered to idols, and those forbidden in the Mosaic
law. These, I grant, are all indifferent, and have their use, though it
is only for a time: then meats, and the organs which receive them, will
together moulder into dust. But the case is quite otherwise with
fornication. This is not indifferent, but at all times evil. For the
body is for the Lord - Designed only for his service. And the Lord, in
an important sense, for the body - Being the saviour of this, as well as
of the soul; in proof of which God hath already raised him from the
dead.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p11">16. <scripRef passage="Gen. ii. 24" id="i.viii.vii-p11.1" parsed="|Gen|2|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.2.24">Gen. ii,
24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p12">17. But he that is joined to the Lord - By faith. Is one
spirit with him - And shall he make himself one flesh with an
harlot?</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p13">18. Flee fornication - All unlawful commerce with women,
with speed, with abhorrence, with all your might. Every sin that a man
commits against his neighbour terminates upon an object out of himself,
and does not so immediately pollute his body, though it does his soul.
But he that committeth fornication, sinneth against his own body -
Pollutes, dishonours, and degrades it to a level with brute beasts.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p14">19. And even your body is not, strictly speaking, your own
even this is the temple of the Holy Ghost - Dedicated to him, and
inhabited by him. What the apostle calls elsewhere "the temple of God,"
chap. iii, 16, 17, and "the temple of the living God," <scripRef passage="2 Cor. vi. 16" id="i.viii.vii-p14.1" parsed="|2Cor|6|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.6.16">2 Cor. vi, 16</scripRef>, he here styles the temple of the Holy Ghost; plainly
showing that the Holy Ghost is the living God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.vii-p15">20. Glorify God with your body, and your spirit - Yield
your bodies and all their members, as well as your souls and all their
faculties, as instruments of righteousness to God. Devote and employ all
ye have, and all ye are, entirely, unreservedly, and forever, to his
glory.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="15.77%" prev="i.viii.vii" next="i.viii.ix" id="i.viii.viii">
<h3 id="i.viii.viii-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. VII" id="i.viii.viii-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.7" /> 

<p id="i.viii.viii-p1">1. It is good for a man - Who is master of himself. Not to
touch a women - That is, not to marry. So great and many are the
advantages of a single life.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p2">2. Yet, when it is needful, in order to avoid fornication,
let every man have his own wife. His own - For Christianity allows no
polygamy.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p3">3. Let not married persons fancy that there is any
perfection in living with each other, as if they were unmarried. The
debt - This ancient reading seems far more natural than the common
one.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p4">4. The wife-the husband - Let no one forget this, on
pretense of greater purity.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p5">5. Unless it be by consent for a time - That on those
special and solemn occasions ye may entirely give yourselves up to the
exercises of devotion. Lest - If ye should long remain separate. Satan
tempt you - To unclean thoughts, if not actions too.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p6">6. But I say this - Concerning your separating for a time
and coming together again. Perhaps he refers also to ver. 2.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p7">7. For I would that all men were herein even as I - I would
that all believers who are now unmarried would remain "eunuchs for the
kingdom of heaven's sake" St. Paul, having tasted the sweetness of this
liberty, wished others to enjoy it, as well as himself. But every one
hath his proper gift from God - According to our Lord's declaration,
"All men cannot receive this saying, save they," the happy few, to whom
it is given," <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 11" id="i.viii.viii-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|19|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.11">Matt. xix,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p8">8. It is good for them if they remain even as I - That St.
Paul was then single is certain and from <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 58" id="i.viii.viii-p8.1" parsed="|Acts|7|58|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.58">Acts vii, 58</scripRef>, compared with the following parts of the history, it seems
probable that he always was so. It does not appear that this
declaration, any more than ver. 1, hath any reference at all to a state
of persecution.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p9">10. Not I - Only. But the Lord - Christ; by his express
command, <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 32" id="i.viii.viii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|5|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.32">Matt. v, 32</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p10">11. But if she depart - Contrary to this express
prohibition. And let not the husband put away his wife - Except for the
cause of adultery.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p11">12. To the rest - Who are married to unbelievers. Speak I -
By Revelation from God, though our Lord hath not left any commandment
concerning it. Let him not put her away - The Jews, indeed, were obliged
of old to put away their idolatrous wives, <scripRef passage="Ezra x. 3" id="i.viii.viii-p11.1" parsed="|Ezra|10|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.10.3">Ezra x, 3</scripRef>; but their case was quite different. They were absolutely
forbid to marry idolatrous women; but the persons here spoken of were
married while they were both in a state of heathenism.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p12">14. For the unbelieving husband hath, in many instances,
been sanctified by the wife - Else your children would have been brought
up heathens; whereas now they are Christians. As if he had said, Ye see
the proof of it before your eyes.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p13">15. A brother or a sister - A Christian man or woman. Is
not enslaved - is at full liberty. In such cases: but God hath called us
to peace - To live peaceably with them, if it be possible.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p14">17. But as God hath distributed - The various stations of
life, and various relations, to every one, let him take care to
discharge his duty therein. The gospel disannuls none of these. And thus
I ordain in all the churches - As a point of the highest concern.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p15">19. Circumcision is nothing, and uncircumcision is nothing
- Will neither promote nor obstruct our salvation. The one point is,
keeping the commandments of God; "faith working by love."</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p16">20. In the calling - The outward state. Wherein he is -
When God calls him. Let him not seek to change this, without a clear
direction from Providence.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p17">21. Care not for it - Do not anxiously seek liberty. But if
thou canst be free, use it rather - Embrace the opportunity.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p18">22. Is the Lord's freeman - Is free in this respect. The
Greek word implies one that was a slave, but now is free. Is the bondman
of Christ - Not free in this respect; not at liberty to do his own
will.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p19">23. Ye are bought with a price - Ye belong to God;
therefore, where it can be avoided, do not become the bondslaves of men
- Which may expose you to many temptations.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p20">24. Therein abide with God - Doing all things as unto God,
and as in his immediate presence. They who thus abide with God preserve
an holy indifference with regard to outward things.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p21">25. Now concerning virgins - Of either sex. I have no
commandment from the Lord - By a particular Revelation. Nor was it
necessary he should; for the apostles wrote nothing which was not
divinely inspired: but with this difference, - sometimes they had a
particular Revelation, and a special commandment; at other times they
wrote from the divine light which abode with them, the standing treasure
of the Spirit of God. And this, also, was not their private opinion, but
a divine rule of faith and practice. As one whom God hath made faithful
in my apostolic office; who therefore faithfully deliver what I receive
from him.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p22">26, 27. This is good for the present distress - While any
church is under persecution. For a man to continue as he is - Whether
married or unmarried. St. Paul does not here urge the present distress
as a reason for celibacy, any more than for marriage; but for a man's
not seeking to alter his state, whatever it be, but making the best of
it.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p23">28. Such will have trouble in the flesh - Many outward
troubles. But I spare you - I speak as little and as tenderly as
possible.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p24">29. But this I say, brethren -- with great confidence. The
time of our abode here is short. It plainly follows, that even they who
have wives be as serious, zealous, active, dead to the world, as devoted
to God, as holy in all manner of conversation, as if they had none - By
so easy a transition does the apostle slide from every thing else to the
one thing needful; and, forgetting whatever is temporal, is swallowed up
in eternity.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p25">30. And they that weep, as if they wept not - "Though
sorrowful, yet always rejoicing." They that rejoice, as if they rejoiced
not - Tempering their joy with godly fear. They that buy, as if they
possessed not - Knowing themselves to be only stewards, not
proprietors.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p26">31. And they that use this world, as not abusing it - Not
seeking happiness in it, but in God: using every thing therein only in
such a manner and degree as most tends to the knowledge and love of God.
For the whole scheme and fashion of this world - This marrying, weeping,
rejoicing, and all the rest, not only will pass, but now passeth away,
is this moment flying off like a shadow.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p27">32. Now I would have you - For this flying moment. Without
carefulness - Without any incumbrance of your thoughts. The unmarried
man - If he understand and use the advantage he enjoys-Careth only for
the things of the Lord, how he may please the Lord.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p28">33. But the married careth for the things of the world -
And it in his duty so to do, so far as becomes a Christian. How he may
please his wife - And provide all things needful for her and his
family.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p29">34. There is a difference also between a wife and a virgin
- Whether the church be under persecution or not. The unmarried woman -
If she know and use her privilege. Careth only for the things of the
Lord - All her time, care, and thoughts center in this, how she may be
holy both in body and spirit. This is the standing advantage of a single
life, in all ages and nations. But who makes a suitable use of it?</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p30">35. Not that I may cast a snare upon you - Who are not able
to receive this saying. But for your profit - Who are able. That ye may
resolutely and perseveringly wait upon the Lord - The word translated
wait signifies sitting close by a person, in a good posture to hear. So
Mary sat at the feet of Jesus, <scripRef passage="Luke x. 39" id="i.viii.viii-p30.1" parsed="|Luke|10|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.39">Luke x,
39</scripRef>. Without distraction - Without having the mind drawn any way
from its center; from its close attention to God; by any person, or
thing, or care, or incumbrance whatsoever.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p31">36. But if any parent think he should otherwise act
indecently - Unbecoming his character. Toward his virgin daughter, if
she be above age, (or of full age,) and need so require, ver. 9, let
them marry - Her suitor and she.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p32">37. Having no necessity - Where there is no such need. But
having power over his own will - Which would incline him to desire the
increase of his family, and the strengthening it by new relations.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p33">38. Doeth better - If there be no necessity.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p34">39. Only in the Lord - That is, only if Christians marry
Christians: a standing direction, and one of the utmost importance.</p>

<p id="i.viii.viii-p35">40. I also - As well as any of you. Have the Spirit of God
- Teaching me all things This does not imply any doubt; but the
strongest certainty of it, together with a reproof of them for calling
it in question. Whoever, therefore, would conclude from hence, that St.
Paul was not certain he had the Spirit of Christ, neither understands
the true import of the words, nor considers how expressly he lays claim
to the Spirit, both in this epistle, chap. ii, 16, xiv, 37, and the
other. <scripRef passage="2 Cor. xiii. 3" id="i.viii.viii-p35.1" parsed="|2Cor|13|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.13.3">2 Cor. xiii, 3</scripRef>. Indeed, it may be doubted whether the word here and
elsewhere translated think, does not always imply the fullest and
strongest assurance. See chap. x, 12.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="15.92%" prev="i.viii.viii" next="i.viii.x" id="i.viii.ix">
<h3 id="i.viii.ix-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. VIII" id="i.viii.ix-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.8" /> 

<p id="i.viii.ix-p1">1. Now concerning the next question you proposed. All of us
have knowledge - A gentle reproof of their self-conceit. Knowledge
without love always puffeth up. Love alone edifies - Builds us up in
holiness.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p2">2. If any man think he knoweth any thing - Aright, unless
so far he is taught by God. He knoweth nothing yet as he ought to know -
Seeing there is no true knowledge without divine love.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p3">3. He is known - That is, approved, by him. <scripRef passage="Psalm i. 6" id="i.viii.ix-p3.1" parsed="|Ps|1|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1.6">Psalm i, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p4">4. We know that an idol is nothing - A mere nominal god,
having no divinity, virtue, or power.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p5">5. For though there be that are called gods - By the
heathens both celestial, (as they style them,) terrestrial, and infernal
deities.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p6">6. Yet to us - Christians. There is but one God - This is
exclusive, not of the One Lord, as if he were an inferior deity; but
only of the idols to which the One God is opposed. From whom are all
things - By creation, providence, and grace. And we for him - The end of
all we are, have, and do. And one Lord - Equally the object of divine
worship. By whom are all things - Created, sustained, and governed. And
we by him - Have access to the Father, and all spiritual blessings.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p7">7. Some eat, with consciousness of the idol - That is,
fancying it is something, and that it makes the meat unlawful to be
eaten. And their conscience, being weak - Not rightly informed. Is
defiled - contracts guilt by doing it.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p8">8. But meat commendeth us not to God - Neither by eating,
nor by refraining from it. Eating and not eating are in themselves
things merely indifferent.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p9">10. For if any one see thee who hast knowledge - Whom he
believes to have more knowledge than himself, and who really hast this
knowledge, that an idol is nothing-sitting down to an entertainment in
an idol temple. The heathens frequently made entertainments in their
temples, on what hath been sacrificed to their idols. Will not the
conscience of him that is weak - Scrupulous. Be encouraged - By thy
example. To eat - Though with a doubting conscience.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p10">11. And through thy knowledge shall the weak brother
perish, for whom Christ died? - And for whom thou wilt not lose a meal's
meat, so far from dying for him! We see, Christ died even for them that
perish.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p11">12. Ye sin against Christ - Whose members they are.</p>

<p id="i.viii.ix-p12">13. If meat - Of any kind. Who will follow this example?
What preacher or private Christian will abstain from any thing lawful in
itself, when it offends a weak brother?</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="15.97%" prev="i.viii.ix" next="i.viii.xi" id="i.viii.x">
<h3 id="i.viii.x-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. IX" id="i.viii.x-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.9" /> 

<p id="i.viii.x-p1">1. Am I not free? am I not an apostle? - That is, Have not
I the liberty of a common Christian? yea, that of an apostle? He
vindicates his apostleship, chap. ix, 1-iii, his apostolical liberty,
chap. ix, 4-19. Have I not seen Jesus Christ? - Without this he could
not have been one of those first grand witnesses. Are not ye my work in
the Lord - A full evidence that God hath sent me? And yet some, it
seems, objected to his being an apostle, because he had not asserted his
privilege in demanding and receiving such maintenance from the churches
as was due to that office.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p2">2. Ye are the seal of my apostleship - Who have received
not only faith by my mouth, but all the gifts of the Spirit by my
hands.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p3">3. My answer to them who examine me - Concerning my
apostleship. Is this - Which I have now given.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p4">4. Have we not power - I and my fellowlabourers. To eat and
to drink - At the expense of those among whom we labour.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p5">5. Have we not power to lead about with us a sister, a wife
- And to demand sustenance for her also? As well as the other apostles -
Who therefore, it is plain, did this. And Peter - Hence we learn,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.x-p6">1. That St. Peter continued to live with his
wife after he became an apostle:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.x-p7">2. That he had no rights as an apostle which
were not common to St. Paul.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p8">6. To forbear working - With our hands.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p9">8. Do I speak as a man - Barely on the authority of human
reason? Does not God also say, in effect, the same thing? The ox that
treadeth out the corn - This was the custom in Judea, and many eastern
nations. In several of them it is retained still. And at this day,
horses tread out the corn in some parts of Germany.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p10">9. Doth God - In this direction. Take care for oxen - Only?
Hath he not a farther meaning? And so undoubtedly he hath in all the
other Mosaic laws of this kind.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p11">10. He who ploweth ought to plow in hope - Of reaping. This
seems to be a proverbial expression. And he that thresheth in hope -
Ought not to be disappointed, ought to eat the fruit of his labours. And
ought they who labour in God's husbandry. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 4" id="i.viii.x-p11.1" parsed="|Deut|25|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.4">Deut. xxv, 4</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p12">11. Is it a great matter if we shall reap as much of your
carnal things - As is needful for our sustenance? Do you give us things
of greater value than those you receive from us?</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p13">12. If others - Whether true or false apostles. Partake of
this power - Have a right to be maintained. Do not we rather - On
account of our having laboured so much more? Lest we should give any
hindrance to the gospel - By giving an occasion of cavil or
reproach.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p14">14. <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 10" id="i.viii.x-p14.1" parsed="|Matt|10|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.10">Matt. x,
10</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p15">15. It were better for me to die than - To give occasion to
them that seek occasion against me, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. xi. 12" id="i.viii.x-p15.1" parsed="|2Cor|11|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.11.12">2
Cor. xi, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p16">17. Willingly - He seems to mean, without receiving
anything. St. Paul here speaks in a manner peculiar to himself. Another
might have preached willingly, and yet have received a maintenance from
the Corinthians. But if he had received anything from them, he would
have termed it preaching unwillingly. And so, in the next verse, another
might have used that power without abusing it. But his own using it at
all, he would have termed abusing it. A dispensation is intrusted to me
- Therefore I dare not refrain.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p17">18. What then is my reward - That circumstance in my
conduct for which I expect a peculiar reward from my great Master? That
I abuse not - Make not an unseasonable use of my power which I have in
preaching the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p18">19. I made myself the servant of all - I acted with as
self-denying a regard to their interest, and as much caution not to
offend them, as if I had been literally their servant or slave. Where is
the preacher of the gospel who treads in the same steps?</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p19">20. To the Jews I became as a Jew - Conforming myself in
all things to their manner of thinking and living, so far as; I could
with innocence. To them that are under the law - Who apprehend
themselves to be still bound by the Mosaic law. As under the law -
Observing it myself, while I am among them. Not that he declared this to
be necessary, or refused to converse with those who did not observe it.
This was the very thing which he condemned in St. Peter, <scripRef passage="Gal. ii. 14" id="i.viii.x-p19.1" parsed="|Gal|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.2.14">Gal. ii, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p20">21. To them that are without the law - The heathens. As
without the law - Neglecting its ceremonies. Being not without the law
to God - But as much as ever under its moral precepts. Under the law to
Christ - And in this sense all Christians will be under the law for
ever.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p21">22. I became as weak - As if I had been scrupulous too. I
became all things to all men - Accommodating myself to all, so far as I
could consistent with truth and sincerity.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p22">24. Know ye not that - In those famous games which are kept
at the isthmus, near your city. They who run in the foot race all run,
though but one receiveth the prize - How much greater encouragement have
you to run; since ye may all receive the prize of your high calling!</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p23">25. And every one that there contendeth is temperate in all
things - To an almost incredible degree; using the most rigorous self
denial in food, sleep, and every other sensual indulgence. A corruptible
crown - A garland of leaves, which must soon wither. The moderns only
have discovered that it is "legal" to do all this and more for an
eternal crown than they did for a corruptible!</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p24">26. I so run, not as uncertainly - I look straight to the
goal; I run straight toward it. I cast away every weight, regard not any
that stand by. I fight not as one that beateth the air - This is a
proverbial expression for a man's missing his blow, and spending his
strength, not on his enemy, but on empty air.</p>

<p id="i.viii.x-p25">27. But I keep under my body - By all kinds of self denial.
And bring it into subjection - To my spirit and to God. The words are
strongly figurative, and signify the mortification of the body of sin,
"by an allusion to the natural bodies of those who were bruised or
subdued in combat. Lest by any means after having preached - The Greek
word means, after having discharged the office of an herald, (still
carrying on the allusion,) whose office it was to proclaim the
conditions, and to display the prizes. I myself should become a
reprobate - Disapproved by the Judge, and so falling short of the prize.
This single text may give us a just notion of the scriptural doctrine of
election and reprobation; and clearly shows us, that particular persons
are not in holy writ represented as elected absolutely and
unconditionally to eternal life, or predestinated absolutely and
unconditionally to eternal death; but that believers in general are
elected to enjoy the Christian privileges on earth; which if they abuse,
those very elect persons will become reprobate. St. Paul was certainly
an elect person, if ever there was one; and yet he declares it was
possible he himself might become a reprobate. Nay, he actually would
have become such, if he had not thus kept his body under, even though he
had been so long an elect person, a Christian, and an apostle.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="16.09%" prev="i.viii.x" next="i.viii.xii" id="i.viii.xi">
<h3 id="i.viii.xi-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. X" id="i.viii.xi-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10" /> 

<p id="i.viii.xi-p1">1. Now - That ye may not become reprobates, consider how
highly favoured your fathers were, who were God's elect and peculiar
people, and nevertheless were rejected by him. They were all under the
cloud - That eminent token of God's gracious presence, which screened
them from the heat of the sun by day, and gave them light by night. And
all passed through the sea - God opening a way through the midst of the
waters. <scripRef passage="Exod. xiii. 21" id="i.viii.xi-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|13|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.13.21">Exod. xiii, 21</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Exod. xiv. 22" id="i.viii.xi-p1.2" parsed="|Exod|14|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.14.22">Exod. xiv, 22</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p2">2. And were all, as it were, baptized unto Moses -
initiated into the religion which he taught them. In the cloud and in
the sea - Perhaps sprinkled here and there with drops of water from the
sea or the cloud, by which baptism might be the more evidently
signified.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p3">3. And all ate the same manna, termed spiritual meat, as it
was typical,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.xi-p4">1. Of Christ and his spiritual benefits:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.xi-p5">2. Of the sacred bread which we eat at his
table. <scripRef passage="Exod. xvi. 15" id="i.viii.xi-p5.1" parsed="|Exod|16|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16.15">Exod. xvi, 15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p6">4. And all drank the same spiritual drink - Typical of
Christ, and of that cup which we drink. For they drank out of the
spiritual or mysterious rock, the wonderful streams of which followed
them in their several journeyings, for many years, through the
wilderness. And that rock was a manifest type of Christ - The Rock of
Eternity, from whom his people derive those streams of blessings which
follow them through all this wilderness. <scripRef passage="Exod. xvii. 6" id="i.viii.xi-p6.1" parsed="|Exod|17|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.17.6">Exod. xvii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p7">5. Yet - Although they had so many tokens of the divine
presence. They were overthrown - With the most terrible marks of his
displeasure.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p8">6. Now these things were our examples - Showing what we are
to expect if, enjoying the like benefits, we commit the like sins. The
benefits are set down in the same order as by Moses in Exodus; the sins
and punishments in a different order; evil desire first, as being the
foundation of all; next, idolatry, ver. 7, 14; then fornication, which
usually accompanied it, ver. 8; the tempting and murmuring against God,
in the following verses. As they desired - Flesh, in contempt of manna. <scripRef passage="Num. xi. 4" id="i.viii.xi-p8.1" parsed="|Num|11|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.11.4">Num. xi, 4</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p9">7. Neither be ye idolaters - And so, "neither murmur ye,"
ver. 10. The other cautions are given in the first person; but these in
the second. And with what exquisite propriety does he vary the person!
It would have been improper to say, Neither let us be idolaters; for he
was himself in no danger of idolatry; nor probably of murmuring against
Christ, or the divine providence. To play - That is, to dance, in honour
of their idol. <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxii. 6" id="i.viii.xi-p9.1" parsed="|Exod|32|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.32.6">Exod. xxxii,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p10">8. And fell in one day three and twenty thousand - Beside
the princes who were afterwards hanged, and those whom the Judges slew
so that there died in all four and twenty thousand. <scripRef passage="Num. xxv. 1, 9" id="i.viii.xi-p10.1" parsed="|Num|25|1|0|0;|Num|25|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.25.1 Bible:Num.25.9">Num. xxv, 1, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p11">9. Neither let us tempt Christ - By our unbelief. St. Paul
enumerates five benefits, ver. 1-4; of which the fourth and fifth were
closely connected together; and five sins, the fourth and fifth of which
were likewise closely connected. In speaking of the fifth benefit, he
expressly mentions Christ; and in speaking of the fourth sin, he shows
it was committed against Christ. As some of them tempted him - This sin
of the people was peculiarly against Christ; for when they had so long
drank of that rock, yet they murmured for want of water. <scripRef passage="Num. xxi. 4" id="i.viii.xi-p11.1" parsed="|Num|21|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.21.4">Num. xxi, 4</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p12">10. The destroyer - The destroying angel. <scripRef passage="Num. xiv. 1, 36" id="i.viii.xi-p12.1" parsed="|Num|14|1|0|0;|Num|14|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.14.1 Bible:Num.14.36">Num. xiv, 1, 36</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p13">11. On whom the ends of the ages are come - The expression
has great force. All things meet together, and come to a crisis, under
the last, the gospel, dispensation; both benefits and dangers,
punishments and rewards. It remains, that Christ come as an avenger and
judge. And even these ends include various periods, succeeding each
other.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p14">12. The common translation runs, Let him that thinketh he
standeth; but the word translated thinketh, most certainly strengthens,
rather than weakens, the sense.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p15">13. Common to man - Or, as the Greek word imports,
proportioned to human strength. God is faithful - In giving the help
which he hath promised. And he will with the temptation - Provide for
your deliverance.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p16">14. Flee from idolatry - And from all approaches to it.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p17">16. The cup which we bless - By setting it apart to a
sacred use, and solemnly invoking the blessing of God upon it. Is it not
the communion of the blood of Christ - The means of our partaking of
those invaluable benefits, which are the purchase of the blood of
Christ. The communion of the body of Christ - The means of our partaking
of those benefits which were purchased by the body of Christ - offered
for us.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p18">17. For it is this communion which makes us all one. We
being many are yet, as it were, but different parts of one and the same
broken bread, which we receive to unite us in one body.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p19">18. Consider Israel after the flesh - Christians are the
spiritual "Israel of God." Are not they who eat of the sacrifices
partakers of the altar - Is not this an act of communion with that God
to whom they are offered? And is not the case the same with those who
eat of the sacrifices which have been offered to idols?</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p20">19. What say I then - Do I in saying this allow that an
idol is anything divine? I aver, on the contrary, that what the heathens
sacrifice, they sacrifice to devils. Such in reality are the gods of the
heathens; and with such only can you hold communion in those
sacrifices.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p21">21. Ye cannot drink the cup of the Lord, and the cup of
devils - You cannot have communion with both.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p22">22. Do we provoke the Lord to jealousy - By thus caressing
his rivals? Are we stronger than he - Are we able to resist, or to bear
his wrath?</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p23">23. Supposing this were lawful in itself, yet it is not
expedient, it is not edifying to my neighbour.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p24">24. His own only, but another's welfare also.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p25">25. The apostle now applies this principle to the point in
question. Asking no questions - Whether it has been sacrificed or
not.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p26">26. For God, who is the Creator, Proprietor, and Disposer
of the earth and all that is therein, hath given the produce of it to
the children of men, to be used without scruple. <scripRef passage="Psalm xxiv. 1" id="i.viii.xi-p26.1" parsed="|Ps|24|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.24.1">Psalm xxiv, 1</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p27">28. For his sake that showed thee, and for conscience' sake
- That is, for the sake of his weak conscience, lest it should be
wounded.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p28">29. Conscience I say, not thy own - I speak of his
conscience, not thine. For why is my liberty judged by another's
conscience - Another's conscience is not the standard of mine, nor is
another's persuasion the measure of my liberty.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p29">30. If I by grace am a partaker - If I thankfully use the
common blessings of God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p30">31. Therefore - To close the present point with a general
rule, applicable not only in this, but in all cases, Whatsoever ye do -
In all things whatsoever, whether of a religious or civil nature, in all
the common, as well as sacred, actions of life, keep the glory of God in
view, and steadily pursue in all this one end of your being, the
planting or advancing the vital knowledge and love of God, first in your
own soul, then in all mankind.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p31">32. Give no offense - If, and as far as, it is
possible.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xi-p32">33. Even as I, as much as lieth in me, please all men.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="16.21%" prev="i.viii.xi" next="i.viii.xiii" id="i.viii.xii">
<h3 id="i.viii.xii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. XI" id="i.viii.xii-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.11" /> 

<p id="i.viii.xii-p1">2. I praise you - The greater part of you.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p2">3. I would have you know - He does not seem to have given
them any order before concerning this. The head of every man -
Particularly every believer. Is Christ, and the head of Christ is God -
Christ, as he is Mediator, acts in all things subordinately to his
Father. But we can no more infer that they are not of the same divine
nature, because God is said to be the head of Christ, than that man and
woman are not of the same human nature, because the man is said to be
the head of the woman.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p3">4. Every man praying or prophesying - Speaking by the
immediate power of God. With his head - And face. Covered - Either with
a veil or with long hair. Dishonoureth his head - St. Paul seems to
mean, As in these eastern nations veiling the head is a badge of
subjection, so a man who prays or prophesies with a veil on his head,
reflects a dishonour on Christ, whose representative he is.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p4">5. But every woman - Who, under an immediate impulse of the
Spirit, (for then only was a woman suffered to speak in the church,)
prays or prophesies without a veil on her face, as it were disclaims
subjection, and reflects dishonour on man, her head. For it is the same,
in effect, as if she cut her hair short, and wore it in the
distinguishing form of the men. In those ages, men wore their hair
exceeding short, as appears from the ancient statues and pictures.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p5">6. Therefore if a woman is not covered - If she will throw
off the badge of subjection, let her appear with her hair cut like a
man's. But if it be shameful far a woman to appear thus in public,
especially in a religious assembly, let her, for the same reason, keep
on her veil.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p6">7. A man indeed ought not to veil his head, because he is
the image of God - In the dominion he bears over the creation,
representing the supreme dominion of God, which is his glory. But the
woman is only matter of glory to the man, who has a becoming dominion
over her. Therefore she ought not to appear, but with her head veiled,
as a tacit acknowledgment of it.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p7">8. The man is not - In the first production of nature.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p8">10. For this cause also a woman ought to be veiled in the
public assemblies, because of the angels - Who attend there, and before
whom they should be careful not to do anything indecent or
irregular.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p9">11. Nevertheless in the Lord Jesus, there is neither male
nor female - Neither is excluded; neither is preferred before the other
in his kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p10">12. And as the woman was at first taken out of the man, so
also the man is now, in the ordinary course of nature, by the woman; but
all things are of God - The man, the woman, and their dependence on each
other.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p11">13. Judge of yourselves - For what need of more arguments
if so plain a case? Is it decent for a woman to pray to God - The Most
High, with that bold and undaunted air which she must have, when,
contrary to universal custom, she appears in public with her head
uncovered?</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p12">14. For a man to have long hair, carefully adjusted, is
such a mark of effeminacy as is a disgrace to him.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p13">15. Given her - Originally, before the arts of dress were
in being.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p14">16. We have no such custom here, nor any of the other
churches of God - The several churches that were in the apostles' time
had different customs in things that were not essential; and that under
one and the same apostle, as circumstances, in different places, made it
convenient. And in all things merely indifferent the custom of each
place was of sufficient weight to determine prudent and peaceable men.
Yet even this cannot overrule a scrupulous conscience, which really
doubts whether the thing be indifferent or no. But those who are
referred to here by the apostle were contentious, not conscientious,
persons.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p15">18. In the church - In the public assembly. I hear there
are schisms among you; and I partly believe it - That is, I believe it
of some of you. It is plain that by schisms is not meant any separation
from the church, but uncharitable divisions in it; for the Corinthians
continued to be one church; and, notwithstanding all their strife and
contention, there was no separation of any one party from the rest, with
regard to external communion. And it is in the same sense that the word
is used, chap. i, 10; chap. xii, 25; which are the only places in the
New Testament, beside this, where church schisms are mentioned.
Therefore, the indulging any temper contrary to this tender care of each
other is the true scriptural schism. This is, therefore, a quite
different thing from that orderly separation from corrupt churches which
later ages have stigmatized as schisms; and have made a pretense for the
vilest cruelties, oppressions, and murders, that have troubled the
Christian world. Both heresies and schisms are here mentioned in very
near the same sense; unless by schisms be meant, rather, those inward
animosities which occasion heresies; that is, outward divisions or
parties: so that whilst one said, "I am of Paul," another, "I am of
Apollos," this implied both schism and heresy. So wonderfully have later
ages distorted the words heresy and schism from their scriptural
meaning. Heresy is not, in all the Bible, taken for "an error in
fundamentals," or in anything else; nor schism, for any separation made
from the outward communion of others. Therefore, both heresy and schism,
in the modern sense of the words, are sins that the scripture knows
nothing of; but were invented merely to deprive mankind of the benefit
of private judgment, and liberty of conscience.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p16">19. There must be heresies - Divisions. Among you - In the
ordinary course of things; and God permits them, that it may appear who
among you are, and who are not, upright of heart.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p17">20. Therefore - That is, in consequence of those schisms.
It is not eating the Lord's supper - That solemn memorial of his death;
but quite another thing.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p18">21. For in eating what ye call the Lord's supper, instead
of all partaking of one bread, each person brings his own supper, and
eats it without staying for the rest. And hereby the poor, who cannot
provide for themselves, have nothing; while the rich eat and drink to
the full just as the heathens use to do at the feasts on their
sacrifices.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p19">22. Have ye not houses to eat and drink your common meals
in? or do ye despise the church of God - Of which the poor are both the
larger and the better part. Do ye act thus in designed contempt of
them?</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p20">23. I received - By an immediate Revelation.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p21">24. This is my body, which is broken for you - That is,
this broken bread is the sign of my body, which is even now to be
pierced and wounded for your iniquities. Take then, and eat of, this
bread, in an humble, thankful, obediential remembrance of my dying love;
of the extremity of my sufferings on your behalf, of the blessings I
have thereby procured for you, and of the obligations to love and duty
which I have by all this laid upon you.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p22">25. After supper - Therefore ye ought not to confound this
with a common meal. Do this in remembrance of me - The ancient
sacrifices were in remembrance of sin: this sacrifice, once offered, is
still represented in remembrance of the remission of sins.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p23">26. Ye show forth the Lord's death - Ye proclaim, as it
were, and openly avow it to God, and to all the world. Till he come - In
glory.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p24">27. Whosoever shall eat this bread unworthily - That is, in
an unworthy, irreverent manner; without regarding either Him that
appointed it, or the design of its appointment. Shall be guilty of
profaning that which represents the body and blood of the Lord.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p25">28. But let a man examine himself - Whether he know the
nature and the design of the institution, and whether it be his own
desire and purpose throughly to comply therewith.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p26">29. For he that eateth and drinketh so unworthily as those
Corinthians did, eateth and drinketh judgment to himself - Temporal
judgments of various kinds, ver. 30. Not distinguishing the sacred
tokens of the Lord's body - From his common food.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p27">30. For this cause - Which they had not observed. Many
sleep - In death.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p28">31. If we would judge ourselves - As to our knowledge, and
the design with which we approach the Lord's table. We should not be
thus judged - That is, punished by God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p29">32. When we are thus judged, it is with this merciful
design, that we may not be finally condemned with the world.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xii-p30">33. The rest - The other circumstances relating to the
Lord's supper.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="16.36%" prev="i.viii.xii" next="i.viii.xiv" id="i.viii.xiii">
<h3 id="i.viii.xiii-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. XII" id="i.viii.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.12" /> 

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p1">1. Now concerning spiritual gifts - The abundance of these
in the churches of Greece strongly refuted the idle learning of the
Greek philosophers. But the Corinthians did not use them wisely, which
occasioned St. Paul's writing concerning them. He describes,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.xiii-p2">1. The unity of the body, ver. 1-xxvii,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.xiii-p3">2. The variety of members and offices, ver.
27-30,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.xiii-p4">3. The way of exercising gifts rightly,
namely, by love, ver. 31, chap. xiii, 1. throughout: and adds,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.viii.xiii-p5">4. A comparison of several gifts with each
other, in the chap. xiv, 1. fourteenth chapter.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p6">2. Ye were heathens - Therefore, whatever gifts ye have
received, it is from the free grace of God. Carried away - By a blind
credulity. After dumb idols - The blind to the dumb; idols of wood and
stone, unable to speak themselves, and much more to open your mouths, as
God has done. As ye were led - By the subtlety of your priests.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p7">3. Therefore - Since the heathen idols cannot speak
themselves, much less give spiritual gifts to others, these must
necessarily be among Christians only. As no one speaking by the Spirit
of God calleth Jesus accursed - That is, as none who does this, (which
all the Jews and heathens did,) speaketh by the Spirit of God - Is
actuated by that Spirit, so as to speak with tongues, heal diseases, or
cast out devils. So no one can say, Jesus is the Lord - None can receive
him as such; for, in the scripture language, to say, or to believe,
implies an experimental assurance. But by the Holy Ghost - The sum is,
None have the Holy Spirit but Christians: all Christians have this
Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p8">4. There are diversities of gifts, but the same Spirit -
Divers streams, but all from one fountain. This verse speaks of the Holy
Ghost, the next of Christ, the sixth of God the Father. The apostle
treats of the Spirit, ver. 7, &amp;c.; of Christ, ver. 12, &amp;c.; of
God, ver. 28, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p9">5. Administrations - Offices. But the same Lord appoints
them all.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p10">6. Operations - Effects produced. This word is of a larger
extent than either of the former. But it is the same God who worketh all
these effects in all the persons concerned.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p11">7. The manifestation - The gift whereby the Spirit
manifests itself. Is given to each - For the profit of the whole
body.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p12">8. The word of wisdom - A power of understanding and
explaining the manifold wisdom of God in the grand scheme of gospel
salvation. The word of knowledge - Perhaps an extraordinary ability to
understand and explain the Old Testament types and prophecies.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p13">9. Faith may here mean an extraordinary trust in God under
the most difficult or dangerous circumstances. The gift of healing need
not be wholly confined to the healing diseases with a word or a touch.
It may exert itself also, though in a lower degree, where natural
remedies are applied; and it may often be this, not superior skill,
which makes some physicians more successful than others. And thus it may
be with regard to other gifts likewise. As, after the golden shields
were lost, the king of Judah put brazen in their place, so, after the
pure gifts were lost, the power of God exerts itself in a more covert
manner, under human studies and helps; and that the more plentifully,
according as there is the more room given for it.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p14">10. The working of other miracles. Prophecy - Foretelling
things to come. The discerning - Whether men be of an upright spirit or
no; whether they have natural or supernatural gifts for offices in the
church; and whether they who profess to speak by inspiration speak from
a divine, a natural, or a diabolical spirit.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p15">11. As he willeth - The Greek word does not so much imply
arbitrary pleasure, as a determination founded on wise counsel.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p16">12. So is Christ - That is, the body of Christ, the
church.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p17">13. For by that one Spirit, which we received in baptism,
we are all united in one body. Whether Jews or gentiles - Who are at the
greatest distance from each other by nature. Whether slaves or freemen -
Who are at the greatest distance by law and custom. We have all drank of
one Spirit - In that cup, received by faith, we all imbibed one Spirit,
who first inspired, and still preserves, the life of God in our
souls.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p18">15. The foot is elegantly introduced as speaking of the
hand; the ear, of the eye; each, of a part that has some resemblance to
it. So among men each is apt to compare himself with those whose gifts
some way resemble his own, rather than with those who are at a distance,
either above or beneath him. Is it therefore not of the body - Is the
inference good? Perhaps the foot may represent private Christians; the
hand, officers in the church; the eye, teachers; the ear, hearers.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p19">16. The ear - A less noble part. The eye - The most
noble.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p20">18. As it hath pleased him - With the most exquisite wisdom
and goodness.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p21">20. But one body - And it is a necessary consequence of
this unity, that the several members need one another.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p22">21. Nor the head - The highest part of all. To the foot -
The very lowest.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p23">22. The members which appear to be weaker - Being of a more
delicate and tender structure; perhaps the brains and bowels, or the
veins, arteries, and other minute channels in the body.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p24">23. We surround with more abundant honour - By so carefully
covering them. More abundant comeliness - By the help of dress.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p25">24. Giving more abundant honour to that which lacked - As
being cared for and served by the noblest parts.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p26">27. Now ye - Corinthians. Are the body and members of
Christ - part of them, I mean, not the whole body.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p27">28. First apostles - Who plant the gospel in the heathen
nations. Secondly prophets - Who either foretel things to come, or speak
by extra-ordinary inspiration, for the edification of the church.
Thirdly teachers - Who precede even those that work miracles. Under
prophets and teachers are comprised evangelists and pastors, <scripRef passage="Eph. iv. 11" id="i.viii.xiii-p27.1" parsed="|Eph|4|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.4.11">Eph. iv, 11</scripRef>. Helps, governments - It does not appear that these mean
distinct offices: rather, any persons might be called helps, from a
peculiar dexterity in helping the distressed; and governments, from a
peculiar talent for governing or presiding in assemblies.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiii-p28">31. Ye covet earnestly the best gifts - And they are worth
your pursuit, though but few of you can attain them. But there is a far
more excellent gift than all these; and one which all may, yea, must
attain or perish.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="16.47%" prev="i.viii.xiii" next="i.viii.xv" id="i.viii.xiv">
<h3 id="i.viii.xiv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. XIII" id="i.viii.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.13" /> 

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p1">The necessity of love is shown, ver. 1-3. The nature and
properties, ver. 4-7. The duration of it, ver. 8-13 Verse</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p2">1. Though I speak with all the tongues - Which are upon
earth, and with the eloquence of an angel. And have not love - The love
of God, and of all mankind for his sake, I am no better before God than
the sounding instruments of brass, used in the worship of some of the
heathen gods. Or a tinkling cymbal - This was made of two pieces of
hollow brass, which, being struck together, made a tinkling, but very
little variety of sound.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p3">2. And though I have the gift of prophecy - Of foretelling
future events. And understand all the mysteries - Both of God's word and
providence. And all knowledge - Of things divine and human, that ever
any mortal attained to. And though I have the highest degree of miracle
working faith, and have not this love, I am nothing.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p4">3. And though I - Deliberately, piece by piece. Give all my
goods to feed the poor, yea, though I deliver up my body to be burned -
Rather than I would renounce my religion. And have not the love -
Hereafter described. It profiteth me nothing - Without this, whatever I
speak, whatever I have, whatever I know, whatever I do, whatever I
suffer, is nothing.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p5">4. The love of God, and of our neighbour for God's sake, is
patient toward, all men. It, suffers all the weakness, ignorance,
errors, and infirmities of the children of God; all the malice and
wickedness of the children of the world: and all this, not only for a
time, but to the end. And in every step toward overcoming evil with
good, it is kind, soft, mild, benign. It inspires the sufferer at once
with the most amiable sweetness, and the most fervent and tender
affection. Love acteth not rashly - Does not hastily condemn any one;
never passes a severe sentence on a slight or sudden view of things. Nor
does it ever act or behave in a violent, headstrong, or precipitate
manner. Is not puffed up - Yea, humbles the soul to the dust.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p6">5. It doth not behave indecently - Is not rude, or
willingly offensive, to any. It renders to all their due - Suitable to
time, person, and all other circumstances. Seeketh not her own - Ease,
pleasure, honour, or temporal advantage. Nay, sometimes the lover of
mankind seeketh not, in some sense, even his own spiritual advantage;
does not think of himself, so long as a zeal for the glory of God and
the souls of men swallows him up. But, though he is all on fire for
these ends, yet he is not provoked to sharpness or unkindness toward any
one. Outward provocations indeed will frequently occur; but he triumphs
over all. Love thinketh no evil - Indeed it cannot but see and hear evil
things, and know that they are so; but it does not willingly think evil
of any; neither infer evil where it does not appear. It tears up, root
and branch, all imagining of what we have not proof. It casts out all
jealousies, all evil surmises, all readiness to believe evil.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p7">6. Rejoiceth not in iniquity - Yea, weeps at either the sin
or folly of even an enemy; takes no pleasure in hearing or in repeating
it, but desires it may be forgotten forever. But rejoiceth in the truth
- Bringing forth its proper fruit, holiness of heart and life. Good in
general is its glory and joy, wherever diffused in all the world.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p8">7. Love covereth all things - Whatever evil the lover of
mankind sees, hears, or knows of any one, he mentions it to none; it
never goes out of his lips, unless where absolute duty constrains to
speak. Believeth all things - Puts the most favourable construction on
everything, and is ever ready to believe whatever may tend to the
advantage of any one character. And when it can no longer believe well,
it hopes whatever may excuse or extenuate the fault which cannot be
denied. Where it cannot even excuse, it hopes God will at length give
repentance unto life. Meantime it endureth all things - Whatever the
injustice, the malice, the cruelty of men can inflict. He can not only
do, but likewise suffer, all things, through Christ who strengtheneth
him.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p9">8. Love never faileth - It accompanies to, and adorns us
in, eternity; it prepares us for, and constitutes, heaven. But whether
there be prophecies, they shall fail - When all things are fulfilled,
and God is all in all. Whether there be tongues, they shall cease - One
language shall prevail among all the inhabitants of heaven, and the low
and imperfect languages of earth be forgotten. The knowledge likewise
which we now so eagerly pursue, shall then vanish away - As starlight is
lost in that of the midday sun, so our present knowledge in the light of
eternity.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p10">9. For we know in part, and we prophesy in part - The
wisest of men have here but short, narrow, imperfect conceptions, even
of the things round about them, and much more of the deep things of God.
And even the prophecies which men deliver from God are far from taking
in the whole of future events, or of that wisdom and knowledge of God
which is treasured up in the scripture Revelation.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p11">10. But when that which is perfect is come - At death and
in the last day. That which is in part shall vanish away - Both that
poor, low, imperfect, glimmering light, which is all the knowledge we
now can attain to; and these slow and unsatisfactory methods of
attaining, as well as of imparting it to others.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p12">11. In our present state we are mere infants in point of
knowledge, compared to what we shall be hereafter. I put away childish
things - Of my own accord, willingly, without trouble.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p13">12. Now we see - Even the things that surround us. But by
means of a glass - Or mirror, which reflects only their imperfect forms,
in a dim, faint, obscure manner; so that our thoughts about them are
puzzling and intricate, and everything is a kind of riddle to us. But
then - We shall see, not a faint reflection, but the objects themselves.
Face to face - Distinctly. Now I know in part - Even when God himself
reveals things to me, great part of them is still kept under the veil.
But then I shall know even as also I am known - In a clear, full,
comprehensive manner; in some measure like God, who penetrates the
center of every object, and sees at one glance through my soul and all
things.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xiv-p14">13. Faith, hope, love - Are the sum of perfection on earth;
love alone is the sum of perfection in heaven.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="16.58%" prev="i.viii.xiv" next="i.viii.xvi" id="i.viii.xv">
<h3 id="i.viii.xv-p0.1">XIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. XIV" id="i.viii.xv-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.14" /> 

<p id="i.viii.xv-p1">1. Follow after love - With zeal, vigour, courage,
patience; else you can neither attain nor keep it. And - In their place,
as subservient to this. Desire spiritual gifts; but especially that ye
may prophesy - The word here does not mean foretelling things to come;
but rather opening and applying the scripture.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p2">2. He that speaketh in an unknown tongue speaks, in effect,
not to men, but to God - Who alone understands him.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p3">4. Edifieth himself - Only, on the most favourable
supposition. The church - The whole congregation.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p4">5. Greater - That is, more useful. By this alone are we to
estimate all our gifts and talents.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p5">6. Revelation - Of some gospel mystery. Knowledge -
Explaining the ancient types and prophecies. Prophecy - Foretelling some
future event. Doctrine - To regulate your tempers and lives. Perhaps
this may be the sense of these obscure words.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p6">7. How shall it be known what is piped or harped - What
music can be made, or what end answered?</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p7">8. Who will prepare himself for the battle - Unless he
understand what the trumpet sounds? suppose a retreat or a march.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p8">9. Unless ye utter by the tongue - Which is miraculously
given you. Words easy to be understood - By your hearers. Ye will speak
to the air - A proverbial expression. Will utterly lose your labour.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p9">11. I shall be a barbarian to him - Shall seem to talk
unintelligible gibberish.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p10">13. That he may be able to interpret - Which was a distinct
gift.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p11">14. If I pray in an unknown tongue - The apostle, as he did
at ver. 6, transfers it to himself. My spirit prayeth - By the power of
the Spirit I understand the words myself. But my understanding is
unfruitful - The knowledge I have is no benefit to others.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p12">15. I will pray with the spirit, but I will pray with the
understanding also - I will use my own understanding, as well as the
power of the Spirit. I will not act so absurdly, as to utter in a
congregation what can edify none but myself.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p13">16. Otherwise how shall he that filleth the place of a
private person - That is, any private hearer. Say Amen - Assenting and
confirming your words, as it was even then usual for the whole
congregation to do.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p14">19. With my understanding - In a rational manner; so as not
only to understand myself, but to be understood by others.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p15">20. Be not children in understanding - This is an admirable
stroke of true oratory! to bring down the height of their spirits, by
representing that wherein they prided themselves most, as mere folly and
childishness. In wickedness be ye infants - Have all the innocence of
that tender age. But in understanding be ye grown men - Knowing religion
was not designed to destroy any of our natural faculties, but to exalt
and improve them, our reason in particular.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p16">21. It is written in the Law - The word here, as
frequently, means the Old Testament. In foreign tongues will I speak to
this people - And so he did. He spake terribly to them by the
Babylonians, when they had set at nought what he had spoken by the
prophets, who used their own language. These words received a farther
accomplishment on the day of pentecost. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxviii. 11" id="i.viii.xv-p16.1" parsed="|Isa|28|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.28.11">Isaiah xxviii, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p17">22. Tongues are intended for a sign to unbelievers - To
engage their attention, and convince them the message is of God. Whereas
prophecy is not so much for unbelievers, as for the confirmation of them
that already believe.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p18">23. Yet - Sometimes prophecy is of more use, even to
unbelievers, than speaking with tongues. For instance: If the whole
church be met together - On some extraordinary occasion. It is probable,
in so large a city, they ordinarily met in several places. And there
come in ignorant persons - Men of learning might have understood the
tongues in which they spoke. It is observable, St. Paul says here,
ignorant persons or unbelievers; but in the next verse, an unbeliever or
an ignorant person. Several bad men met together hinder each other by
evil discourse. Single persons are more easily gained.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p19">24. He is convicted by all - who speak in their turns, and
speak to the heart of the hearers. He is judged by all - Everyone says
something to which his conscience bears witness.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p20">25. The secrets of his heart are made manifest - Laid open,
clearly described; in a manner which to him is most astonishing and
utterly unaccountable. How many instances of it are seen at this day! So
does God still point his word.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p21">26. What a thing is it, brethren -- this was another
disorder among them. Everyone hath a psalm - That is, at the same time
one begins to sing a psalm; another to deliver a doctrine; another to
speak in an unknown tongue; another to declare what has been revealed to
him; another to interpret what the former is speaking; every one
probably gathering a little company about him, just as they did in the
schools of the philosophers. Let all be done to edification - So as to
profit the hearers.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p22">27. By two or three at most - Let not above two or three
speak at one meeting. And that by course - That is, one after another.
And let one interpret - Either himself, ver. 13; or, if he have not the
gift, some other, into the vulgar tongue. It seems, the gift of tongues
was an instantaneous knowledge of a tongue till then unknown, which he
that received it could afterwards speak when he thought fit, without any
new miracle.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p23">28. Let him speak - That tongue, if he find it profitable
to himself in his private devotions.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p24">29. Let two or three of the prophets - Not more, at one
meeting. Speak - One after another, expounding the scripture.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p25">31. All - Who have that gift. That all may learn - Both by
speaking and by hearing.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p26">32. For the spirits of the prophets are subject to the
prophets - But what enthusiast considers this? The impulses of the Holy
Spirit, even in men really inspired, so suit themselves to their
rational faculties, as not to divest them of the government of
themselves, like the heathen priests under their diabolical possession.
Evil spirits threw their prophets into such ungovernable ecstasies, as
forced them to speak and act like madmen. But the Spirit of God left his
prophets the clear use of their judgment, when, and how long, it was fit
for them to speak, and never hurried them into any improprieties either
as to the matter, manner, or time of their speaking.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p27">34. Let your women be silent in the churches - Unless they
are under an extraordinary impulse of the Spirit. For, in other cases,
it is not permitted them to speak - By way of teaching in public
assemblies. But to be in subjection - To the man whose proper office it
is to lead and to instruct the congregation. <scripRef passage="Gen. iii. 16" id="i.viii.xv-p27.1" parsed="|Gen|3|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.3.16">Gen. iii, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p28">35. And even if they desire to learn anything - Still they
are not to speak in public, but to ask their own husbands at home - That
is the place, and those the persons to inquire of.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p29">36. Are ye of Corinth either the first or the only
Christians? If not, conform herein to the custom of all the
churches.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p30">37. Or spiritual - Endowed with any extraordinary gift of
the Spirit. Let him - Prove it, by acknowledging that I now write by the
Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p31">38. Let him be ignorant - Be it at his own peril.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p32">39. Therefore - To sum up the whole.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xv-p33">40. Decently - By every individual. In order - By the whole
church.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="16.71%" prev="i.viii.xv" next="i.viii.xvii" id="i.viii.xvi">
<h3 id="i.viii.xvi-p0.1">XV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. XV" id="i.viii.xvi-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.15" /> 

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p1">2. Ye are saved, if ye hold fast - Your salvation is begun,
and will be perfected, if ye continue in the faith. Unless ye have
believed in vain - Unless indeed your faith was only a delusion.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p2">3. I received - From Christ himself. It was not a fiction
of my own. <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 8, 9" id="i.viii.xvi-p2.1" parsed="|Isa|53|8|53|9" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.8-Isa.53.9">Isaiah liii, 8,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p3">4. According to the scriptures - He proves it first from
scripture, then from the testimony of a cloud of witnesses. <scripRef passage="Psalm xvi. 10" id="i.viii.xvi-p3.1" parsed="|Ps|16|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.16.10">Psalm xvi, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p4">5. By the twelve - This was their standing appellation; but
their full number was not then present.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p5">6. Above five hundred - Probably in Galilee. A glorious and
incontestable proof! The greater part remain - Alive.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p6">7. Then by all the apostles - The twelve were mentioned
ver. 5. This title here, therefore, seems to include the seventy; if not
all those, likewise, whom God afterwards sent to plant the gospel in
heathen nations.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p7">8. An untimely birth - It was impossible to abase himself
more than he does by this single appellation. As an abortion is not
worthy the name of a man, so he affirms himself to be not worthy the
name of an apostle.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p8">9. I persecuted the church - True believers are humbled all
their lives, even for the sins they committed before they believed.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p9">10. I laboured more than they all - That is, more than any
of them, from a deep sense of the peculiar love God had shown me. Yet,
to speak more properly, it is not I, but the grace of God that is with
me - This it is which at first qualified me for the work, and still
excites me to zeal and diligence in it.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p10">11. Whether I or they, so we preach - All of us speak the
same thing.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p11">12. How say some - Who probably had been heathen
philosophers.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p12">13. If there be no resurrection - If it be a thing flatly
impossible.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p13">14. Then is our preaching - From a commission supposed to
be given after the resurrection. Vain - Without any real foundation.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p14">15. If the dead rise not - If the very notion of a
resurrection be, as they say, absurd and impossible.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p15">17. Ye are still in your sins - That is, under the guilt of
them. So that there needed something more than reformation, (which was
plainly wrought,) in order to their being delivered from the guilt of
sin even that atonement, the sufficiency of which God attested by
raising our great Surety from the grave.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p16">18. They who sleep in Christ - Who have died for him, or
believing in him. Are perished - Have lost their life and being
together.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p17">19. If in this life only we have hope - If we look for
nothing beyond the grave. But if we have a divine evidence of things not
seen, if we have "a hope full of immortality," if we now taste of "the
powers of the world to come," and see "the crown that fadeth not away,"
then, notwithstanding" all our present trials, we are more happy than
all men.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p18">20. But now - St. Paul declares that Christians "have
hope," not "in this life only." His proof of the resurrection lies in a
narrow compass, ver. 12-19. Almost all the rest of the chapter is taken
up in illustrating, vindicating, and applying it. The proof is short,
but solid and convincing, that which arose from Christ's resurrection.
Now this not only proved a resurrection possible, but, as it proved him
to be a divine teacher, proved the certainty of a general resurrection,
which he so expressly taught. The first fruit of them that slept - The
earnest, pledge, and insurance of their resurrection who slept in him:
even of all the righteous. It is of the resurrection of these, and these
only, that the apostle speaks throughout the chapter.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p19">22. As through Adam all, even the righteous, die, so
through Christ all these shall be made alive - He does not say, "shall
revive," (as naturally as they die,) but shall be made alive, by a power
not their own.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p20">23. Afterward - The whole harvest. At the same time the
wicked shall rise also. But they are not here taken into the
account.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p21">24. Then - After the resurrection and the general judgment.
Cometh the end - Of the world; the grand period of all those wonderful
scenes that have appeared for so many succeeding generations. When he
shall have delivered up the kingdom to the Father, and he (the Father)
shall have abolished all adverse rule, authority, and power - Not that
the Father will then begin to reign without the Son, nor will the Son
then cease to reign. For the divine reign both of the Father and Son is
from everlasting to everlasting. But this is spoken of the Son's
mediatorial kingdom, which will then be delivered up, and of the
immediate kingdom or reign of the Father, which will then commence. Till
then the Son transacts the business which the Father hath given him, for
those who are his, and by them as well as by the angels, with the
Father, and against their enemies. So far as the Father gave the kingdom
to the Son, the Son shall deliver it up to the Father, <scripRef passage="John xiii. 3" id="i.viii.xvi-p21.1" parsed="|John|13|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.13.3">John xiii, 3</scripRef>. Nor does the Father cease to reign, when he gives it to the
Son; neither the Son, when he delivers it to the Father: but the glory
which he had before the world began, <scripRef passage="John xvii. 5" id="i.viii.xvi-p21.2" parsed="|John|17|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.17.5">John xvii, 5</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Heb. i. 8" id="i.viii.xvi-p21.3" parsed="|Heb|1|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.1.8">Heb. i, 8</scripRef>, will remain even after this is delivered up. Nor will he
cease to be a king even in his human nature, <scripRef passage="Luke i. 33" id="i.viii.xvi-p21.4" parsed="|Luke|1|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1.33">Luke i, 33</scripRef>. If the citizens of the new Jerusalem" shall reign for
ever," <scripRef passage="Rev. xxii. 5" id="i.viii.xvi-p21.5" parsed="|Rev|22|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.22.5">Rev. xxii, 5</scripRef>, how much more shall he?</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p22">25. He must reign - Because so it is written. Till he - the
Father hath put all his enemies under his feet. <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 1" id="i.viii.xvi-p22.1" parsed="|Ps|110|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.1">Psalm cx, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p23">26. The last enemy that is destroyed is death - Namely,
after Satan, <scripRef passage="Heb. ii. 14" id="i.viii.xvi-p23.1" parsed="|Heb|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.2.14">Heb. ii, 14</scripRef>, and sin, ver. 56, are destroyed. In the same order they
prevailed. Satan brought in sin, and sin brought forth death. And
Christ, when he of old engaged with these enemies, first conquered
Satan, then sin, in his death; and, lastly, death, in his resurrection.
In the same order he delivers all the faithful from them, yea, and
destroys these enemies themselves. Death he so destroys that it shall be
no more; sin and Satan, so that they shall no more hurt his people.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p24">27. Under him - Under the Son. <scripRef passage="Psalm viii. 6, 7" id="i.viii.xvi-p24.1" parsed="|Ps|8|6|8|7" osisRef="Bible:Ps.8.6-Ps.8.7">Psalm viii, 6, 7</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p25">28. The Son also shall be subject - Shall deliver up the
mediatorial kingdom. That the three-one God may be all in all - All
things, (consequently all persons,) without any interruption, without
the intervention of any creature, without the opposition of any enemy,
shall be subordinate to God. All shall say, "My God, and my all." This
is the end. Even an inspired apostle can see nothing beyond this.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p26">29. Who are baptized for the dead - Perhaps baptized in
hope of blessings to be received after they are numbered with the dead.
Or, "baptized in the room of the dead" - Of them that are just fallen in
the cause of Christ: like soldiers who advance in the room of their
companions that fell just before their face.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p27">30. Why are we - The apostles. Also in danger every hour -
It is plain we can expect no amends in this life.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p28">31. I protest by your rejoicing, which I have - Which love
makes my own. I die daily - I am daily in the very jaws of death. Beside
that I live, as it were, in a daily martyrdom.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p29">32. If to speak after the manner of men - That is, to use a
proverbial phrase, expressive of the most imminent danger I have fought
with wild beasts at Ephesus - With the savage fury of a lawless
multitude, <scripRef passage="Acts xix. 29" id="i.viii.xvi-p29.1" parsed="|Acts|19|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.19.29">Acts xix, 29</scripRef>, &amp;c. This seems to have been but just before. Let as
eat, &amp;c. - We might, on that supposition, as well say, with the
Epicureans, Let us make the best of this short life, seeing we have no
other portion.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p30">33. Be not deceived - By such pernicious counsels as this.
Evil communications corrupt good manners - He opposes to the Epicurean
saying, a well - known verse of the poet Menander. Evil communications -
Discourse contrary to faith, hope, or love, naturally tends to destroy
all holiness.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p31">34. Awake - An exclamation full of apostolical majesty.
Shake off your lethargy! To righteousness - Which flows from the true
knowledge of God, and implies that your whole soul be broad awake. And
sin not - That is, and ye will not sin. Sin supposes drowsiness of soul.
There is need to press this. For some among you have not the knowledge
of God - With all their boasted knowledge, they are totally ignorant of
what it most concerns them to know. I speak this to your shame - For
nothing is more shameful, than sleepy ignorance of God, and of the word
and works of God; in these especially, considering the advantages they
had enjoyed.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p32">35. But some one possibly will say, How are the dead raised
up, after their whole frame is dissolved? And with what kind of bodies
do they come again, after these are mouldered into dust?</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p33">36. To the inquiry concerning the manner of rising, and the
quality of the bodies that rise, the Apostle answers first by a
similitude, ver. 36-42, and then plainly and directly, ver. 42, 43. That
which thou sowest, is not quickened into new life and verdure, except it
die - Undergo a dissolution of its parts, a change analogous to death.
Thus St. Paul inverts the objection; as if he had said, Death is so far
from hindering life, that it necessarily goes before it.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p34">37. Thou sowest not the body that shall be - Produced from
the seed committed to the ground, but a bare, naked grain, widely
different from that which will afterward rise out of the earth.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p35">38. But God - Not thou, O man, not the grain itself, giveth
it a body as it hath pleased him, from the time he distinguished the
various Species of beings; and to each of the seeds, not only of the
fruits, but animals also, (to which the Apostle rises in the following
verse,) its own body; not only peculiar to that species, but proper to
that individual, and arising out of the substance of that very
grain.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p36">39. All flesh - As if he had said, Even earthy bodies
differ from earthy, and heavenly bodies from heavenly. What wonder then,
if heavenly bodies differ from earthy? or the bodies which rise from
those that lay in the grave?</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p37">40. There are also heavenly bodies - As the sun, moon, and
stars; and there are earthy - as vegetables and animals. But the
brightest lustre which the latter can have is widely different from that
of the former.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p38">41. Yea, and the heavenly bodies themselves differ from
each other.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p39">42. So also is the resurrection of the dead - So great is
the difference between the body which fell, and that which rises. It is
sown - A beautiful word; committed, as seed, to the ground. In
corruption - Just ready to putrefy, and, by various degrees of
corruption and decay, to return to the dust from whence it came. It is
raised in incorruption - Utterly incapable of either dissolution or
decay.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p40">43. It is sown in dishonour - Shocking to those who loved
it best, human nature in disgrace! It is raised in glory - Clothed with
robes of light, fit for those whom the King of heaven delights to
honour. It is sown in weakness - Deprived even of that feeble strength
which it once enjoyed. It is raised in power - Endued with vigour,
strength, and activity, such as we cannot now conceive.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p41">44. It is sown in this world a merely animal body -
Maintained by food, sleep, and air, like the bodies of brutes: but it is
raised of a more refined contexture, needing none of these animal
refreshments, and endued with qualities of a spiritual nature, like the
angels of God.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p42">45. The first Adam was made a living soul - God gave him
such life as other animals enjoy: but the last Adam, Christ, is a
quickening spirit - As he hath life in himself, so he quickeneth whom he
will; giving a more refined life to their very bodies at the
resurrection. <scripRef passage="Gen. ii. 7" id="i.viii.xvi-p42.1" parsed="|Gen|2|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.2.7">Gen. ii, 7</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p43">47. The first man was from the earth, earthy; the second
man is the Lord from heaven-The first man, being from the earth, is
subject to corruption and dissolution, like the earth from which he
came. The second man - St. Paul could not so well say, "Is from heaven,
heavenly:" because, though man owes it to the earth that he is earthy,
yet the Lord does not owe his glory to heaven. He himself made the
heavens, and by descending from thence showed himself to us as the Lord.
Christ was not the second man in order of time; but in this respect,
that as Adam was a public person, who acted in the stead of all mankind,
so was Christ. As Adam was the first general representative of men,
Christ was the second and the last. And what they severally did,
terminated not in themselves, but affected all whom they
represented.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p44">48. They that are earthy - Who continue without any higher
principle. They that are heavenly - Who receive a divine principle from
heaven.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p45">49. The image of the heavenly - Holiness and glory.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p46">50. But first we must be entirely changed; for such flesh
and blood as we are clothed with now, cannot enter into that kingdom
which is wholly spiritual: neither doth this corruptible body inherit
that incorruptible kingdom.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p47">51. A mystery - A truth hitherto unknown; and not yet fully
known to any of the sons of men. We - Christians. The Apostle considers
them all as one, in their succeeding generations. Shall not all die -
Suffer a separation of soul and body. But we shall all - Who do not die,
be changed - So that this animal body shall become spiritual.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p48">52. In a moment - Amazing work of omnipotence! And cannot
the same power now change us into saints in a moment? The trumpet shall
sound - To awaken all that sleep in the dust of the earth.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p49">54. Death is swallowed up in victory - That is, totally
conquered, abolished forever.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p50">55. O death, where is thy sting? - Which once was full of
hellish poison. O hades, the receptacle of separate souls, where is thy
victory - Thou art now robbed of all thy spoils; all thy captives are
set at liberty. Hades literally means the invisible world, and relates
to the soul; death, to the body. The Greek words are found in the
Septuagint translation of <scripRef passage="Hosea xiii. 14" id="i.viii.xvi-p50.1" parsed="|Hos|13|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.13.14">Hosea xiii,
14</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxv. 8" id="i.viii.xvi-p50.2" parsed="|Isa|25|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.25.8">Isaiah xxv,
8</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p51">56. The sting of death is sin - Without which it could have
no power. But this sting none can resist by his own strength. And the
strength of sin is the law - As is largely declared, <scripRef passage="Rom. vii. 7" id="i.viii.xvi-p51.1" parsed="|Rom|7|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.7.7">Rom. vii, 7</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p52">57. But thanks be to God, who hath given us the victory -
Over sin, death, and hades.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvi-p53">58. Be ye steadfast - In yourselves. Unmovable - By others;
continually increasing in the work of faith and labour of love. Knowing
your labour is not in vain in the Lord - Whatever ye do for his sake
shall have its full reward in that day. Let us also endeavour, by
cultivating holiness in all its branches, to maintain this hope in its
full energy; longing for that glorious day, when, in the utmost extent
of the expression, death shall be swallowed up forever, and millions of
voices, after the long silence of the grave, shall burst out at once
into that triumphant song, O death, where is thy sting? O hades, where
is thy victory?</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="16.96%" prev="i.viii.xvi" next="i.ix" id="i.viii.xvii">
<h3 id="i.viii.xvii-p0.1">XVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Cor. XVI" id="i.viii.xvii-p0.2" parsed="|1Cor|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.16" /> 

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p1">1. The saints - A more solemn and a more affecting word,
than if he had said, the poor.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p2">2. Let every one - Not the rich only: let him also that
hath little, gladly give of that little. According as he hath been
prospered - Increasing his alms as God increases his substance.
According to this lowest rule of Christian prudence, if a man when he
has or gains one pound give a tenth to God, when he has or gains an
hundred he will give the tenth of this also. And yet I show unto you a
more excellent way. He that hath ears to hear, let him hear. Stint
yourself to no proportion at all. But lend to God all you can.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p3">4. They shall go with me - To remove any possible
suspicion.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p4">5. I pass through Macedonia - I purpose going that way.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p5">7. I will not see you now - Not till I have been in
Macedonia.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p6">8. I will stay at Ephesus - Where he was at this time.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p7">9. A great door - As to the number of hearers. And
effectual - As to the effects wrought upon them. And there are many
adversaries - As there must always be where Satan's kingdom shakes. This
was another reason for his staying there.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p8">10. Without fear - Of any one's despising him for his
youth. For he worketh the work of the Lord - The true ground of
reverence to pastors. Those who do so, none ought to despise.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p9">11. I look for him with the brethren -- that accompany
him.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p10">12. I besought him much - To come to you. With the brethren
- Who were then going to Corinth. Yet he was by no means willing to come
now - Perhaps lest his coming should increase the divisions among
them.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p11">13. To conclude. Watch ye - Against all your seen and
unseen enemies. Stand fast in the faith - Seeing and trusting him that
is invisible. Acquit yourselves like men - With courage and patience. Be
strong - To do and suffer all his will.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p12">15. The first fruits of Achaia - The first converts in that
province.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p13">16. That ye also - In your turn. Submit to such - So
repaying their free service. And to every one that worketh with us and
laboureth - That labours in the gospel either with or without a fellow-
labourer.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p14">17. I rejoice at the coming of Stephanas, and Fortunatus,
and Achaiacus - Who were now returned to Corinth but the joy which their
arrival had occasioned remained still in his heart. They have supplied
what was wanting on your part - They have performed the offices of love,
which you could not, by reason of your absence.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p15">18. For they have refreshed my spirit and yours - Inasmuch
as you share in my comfort. Such therefore acknowledge - With suitable
love and respect.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p16">19. Aquila and Priscilla had formerly made some abode at
Corinth, and there St. Paul's acquaintance with them began, <scripRef passage="Acts xviii. 1, 2" id="i.viii.xvii-p16.1" parsed="|Acts|18|1|18|2" osisRef="Bible:Acts.18.1-Acts.18.2">Acts xviii, 1, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p17">21. With my own hand - What precedes having been written by
an amanuensis.</p>

<p id="i.viii.xvii-p18">22. If any man love not the Lord Jesus Christ - If any be
an enemy to his person, offices, doctrines, or commands. Let him be
Anathema. Maran-atha-Anathema signifies a thing devoted to destruction.
It seems to have been customary with the Jews of that age, when they had
pronounced any man an Anathema, to add the Syriac expression,
Maran-atha, that is, "The Lord cometh;" namely, to execute vengeance
upon him. This weighty sentence the apostle chose to write with his own
hand; and to insert it between his salutation and solemn benediction,
that it might be the more attentively regarded.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S SECOND EPISTLE TO THE CORINTHIANS" progress="17.02%" prev="i.viii.xvii" next="i.ix.i" id="i.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2Cor" id="i.ix-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.ix-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S SECOND EPISTLE TO THE CORINTHIANS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Second Corinthians" progress="17.02%" prev="i.ix" next="i.ix.ii" id="i.ix.i">

<p id="i.ix.i-p1">IN this epistle, written from Macedonia, within a year
after the former, St. Paul beautifully displays his tender affection
toward the Corinthians, who were greatly moved by the seasonable
severity of the former, and repeats several of the admonitions he had
there given them. In that he had written concerning the affairs of the
Corinthians: in this he writes chiefly concerning his own; but in such a
manner as to direct all he mentions of himself to their spiritual
profit. The thread and connection of the whole epistle is historical:
other things are interwoven only by way of digression. It contains,</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.ix.i-p2">I.The inscription, C.i. 1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.ix.i-p3">II.The treatise itself.</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ix.i-p4">1. In Asia I was greatly pressed; but God
comforted me; as I acted uprightly; even in this, that I have not yet
come to you; who ought to obey me, Cii. 11</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ix.i-p5">2. From Troas I hastened to Macedonia,
spreading the gospel everywhere, the glorious charge of which I execute,
according to its importance, Cvii. 1</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ix.i-p6">3. In Macedonia I received a joyful message
concerning you, 2-16</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ix.i-p7">4. In this journey I had a proof of the
liberality of the Macedonians, whose example ye ought to follow,
C.viii.1-C.ix.15</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.ix.i-p8">5. I am now on my way to you, armed with the
power of Christ. Therefore obey, C.x 1-C.xiii.10 The conclusion
11-13</p>
<h2 id="i.ix.i-p8.1">2nd CORINTHIANS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="17.05%" prev="i.ix.i" next="i.ix.iii" id="i.ix.ii">
<h3 id="i.ix.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. I" id="i.ix.ii-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.1" /> 

<p id="i.ix.ii-p1">1. Timotheus our brother - St. Paul writing to Timotheus
styled him his son; writing of him, his brother.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p2">3. Blessed be the God and Father of our Lord Jesus Christ -
A solemn and beautiful introduction, highly suitable to the apostolical
spirit. The Father of mercies, and God of all comfort - Mercies are the
fountain of comfort; comfort is the outward expression of mercy. God
shows mercy in the affliction itself. He gives comfort both in and after
the affliction. Therefore is he termed, the God of all comfort. Blessed
be this God!</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p3">4. Who comforteth us in all our affliction, that we may be
able to comfort them who are in any affliction - He that has experienced
one kind of affliction is able to comfort others in that affliction. He
that has experienced all kinds of affliction is able to comfort them in
all.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p4">5. For as the sufferings of Christ abound in us - The
sufferings endured on his account. So our comfort also aboundeth through
Christ - The sufferings were many, the comfort one; and yet not only
equal to, but overbalancing, them all.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p5">6. And whether we are afflicted, it is for your comfort and
salvation - For your present comfort, your present and future salvation.
Or whether we are comforted, it is for your comfort - That we may be the
better able to comfort you. Which is effectual in the patient enduring
the same sufferings which we also suffer - Through the efficacy of which
you patiently endure the same kind of sufferings with us.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p6">7. And our hope concerning you - Grounded on your patience
in suffering for Christ's sake, is steadfast.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p7">8. We would not have you ignorant, brethren, of the trouble
which befell us in Asia - Probably the same which is described in the
nineteenth chapter of the Acts. The Corinthians knew before that he had
been in trouble: he now declares the greatness and the fruit of it. We
were exceedingly pressed, above our strength - Above the ordinary
strength even of an apostle.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p8">9. Yea, we had the sentence of death in ourselves - We
ourselves expected nothing but death.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p9">10. We trust that he will still deliver - That we may at
length be able to come to you.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p10">11. You likewise - As well as other churches. Helping with
us by prayer, that for the gift - Namely, my deliverance. Bestowed upon
us by means of many persons - Praying for it, thanks may be given by
many.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p11">12. For I am the more emboldened to look for this, because
I am conscious of my integrity; seeing this is our rejoicing - Even in
the deepest adversity. The testimony of our conscience - Whatever others
think of us. That in simplicity - Having one end in view, aiming singly
at the glory of God. And godly sincerity - Without any tincture of
guile, dissimulation, or disguise. Not with carnal wisdom, but by the
grace of God - Not by natural, but divine, wisdom. We have had our
conversation in the world - In the whole world; in every
circumstance.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p12">14. Ye have acknowledged us in part - Though not so fully
as ye will do. That we are you rejoicing - That ye rejoice in having
known us. As ye also are ours - As we also rejoice in the success of our
labours among you; and we trust shall rejoice therein in the day of the
Lord Jesus.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p13">15. In this confidence - That is, being confident of
this.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p14">17. Did I use levity - Did I lightly change my purpose? Do
I purpose according to the flesh - Are my purposes grounded on carnal or
worldly considerations? So that there should be with me yea and nay -
Sometimes one, sometimes the other; that is, variableness and
inconstancy.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p15">18. Our word to you - The whole tenor of our doctrine. Hath
not been yea and nay - Wavering and uncertain.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p16">19. For Jesus Christ, who was preached by us - That is, our
preaching concerning him. Was not yea and nay - Was not variable and
inconsistent with itself. But was yea in him - Always one and the same,
centering in him.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p17">20. For all the promises of God are yea and amen in him -
Are surely established in and through him. They are yea with respect to
God promising; amen, with respect to men believing; yea, with respect to
the apostles; amen, with respect to their hearers.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p18">21. I say, to the glory of God - For it is God alone that
is able to fulfil these promises. That establisheth us - Apostles and
teachers. With you - All true believers. In the faith of Christ; and
hath anointed us - With the oil of gladness, with joy in the Holy Ghost,
thereby giving us strength both to do and suffer his will.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p19">22. Who also hath sealed us - Stamping his image on our
hearts, thus marking and sealing us as his own property. And given us
the earnest of his Spirit - There is a difference between an earnest and
a pledge. A pledge is to be restored when the debt is paid; but an
earnest is not taken away, but completed. Such an earnest is the Spirit.
The first fruits of it we have <scripRef passage="Rom. viii. 23" id="i.ix.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Rom|8|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.8.23">Rom.
viii, 23</scripRef>; and we wait for all the fulness.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p20">23. I call God for a record upon my soul - Was not St. Paul
now speaking by the Spirit? And can a more solemn oath be conceived? Who
then can imagine that Christ ever designed to forbid all swearing? That
to spare you I came not yet to Corinth - Lest I should be obliged to use
severity. He says elegantly to Corinth, not to you, when be is
intimating his power to punish.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ii-p21">24. Not that we have dominion over your faith - This is the
prerogative of God alone. But are helpers of your joy - And faith from
which it springs. For by faith ye have stood - To this day. We see the
light in which ministers should always consider themselves, and in which
they are to be considered by others. Not as having dominion over the
faith of their people, and having a right to dictate by their own
authority what they shall believe, or what they shall do; but as helpers
of their joy, by helping them forward in faith and holiness. In this
view, how amiable does their office appear! and how friendly to the
happiness of mankind! How far, then, are they from true benevolence, who
would expose it to ridicule and contempt!</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="17.15%" prev="i.ix.ii" next="i.ix.iv" id="i.ix.iii">
<h3 id="i.ix.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. II" id="i.ix.iii-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.2" /> 

<p id="i.ix.iii-p1">1. In grief - Either on account of the particular offender,
or of the church in general.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p2">2. For if I grieve you, who is he that cheereth me, but he
that is grieved by me - That is, I cannot be comforted myself till his
grief is removed.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p3">3. And I wrote thus to you - I wrote to you before in this
determination, not to come to you in grief.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p4">4. From much anguish I wrote to you, not so much that ye
might be grieved, as that ye might know by my faithful admonition my
abundant love toward you.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p5">5. He hath grieved me but in part - Who still rejoice over
the greater part of you. Otherwise I might burden you all.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p6">6. Sufficient for such an one - With what a remarkable
tenderness does St. Paul treat this offender! He never once mentions his
name. Nor does he here so much as mention his crime. By many - Not only
by the rulers of the church: the whole congregation acquiesced in the
sentence.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p7">10. To whom ye forgive - He makes no question of their
complying with his direction. Anything - So mildly does he speak even of
that heinous sin, after it was repented of. In the person of Christ - By
the authority wherewith he has invested me.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p8">11. Lest Satan - To whom he had been delivered, and who
sought to destroy not only his flesh, but his soul also. Get an
advantage over us - For the loss of one soul is a common loss.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p9">12. Now when I came to Troas - It seems, in that passage
from Asia to Macedonia, of which a short account is given, <scripRef passage="Acts xx. 1, 2" id="i.ix.iii-p9.1" parsed="|Acts|20|1|20|2" osisRef="Bible:Acts.20.1-Acts.20.2">Acts xx, 1, 2</scripRef>. Even though a door was opened to me - That is, there was
free liberty to speak, and many were willing to hear: yet,</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p10">13. I had no rest in my spirit - From an earnest desire to
know how my letter had been received. Because I did not find Titus - In
his return from you. So I went forth into Macedonia - Where being much
nearer, I might more easily be informed concerning you. The apostle
resumes the thread of his discourse, chap. vii, 2, interposing an
admirable digression concerning what he had done and suffered elsewhere,
the profit of which he by this means derives to the Corinthians also;
and as a prelude to his apology against the false apostles.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p11">14. To triumph, implies not only victory, but an open
manifestation of it. And as in triumphal processions, especially in the
east, incense and perfumes were burned near the conqueror, the apostle
beautifully alludes to this circumstance in the following verse: as
likewise to the different effects which strong perfumes have upon
different persons; some of whom they revive, while they throw others
into the most violent disorders.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p12">15. For we - The preachers of the gospel. Are to God a
sweet odour of Christ - God is well-pleased with this perfume diffused
by us, both in them that believe and are saved, treated of, chap. iii,
1; chap. iv, 2; and in them that obstinately disbelieve and,
consequently, perish, treated of, chap. iv, 3-6.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p13">16. And who is sufficient for these things - No man living,
but by the power of God's Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iii-p14">17. For we are not as many, who adulterate the word of God
- Like those vintners (so the Greek word implies) who mix their wines
with baser liquors. But as of sincerity - Without any mixture. But as
from God - This rises higher still; transmitting his pure word, not our
own. In the sight of God - Whom we regard as always present, and noting
every word of our tongue. Speak we - The tongue is ours, but the power
is God's. In Christ - Words which he gives, approves, and blesses.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="17.21%" prev="i.ix.iii" next="i.ix.v" id="i.ix.iv">
<h3 id="i.ix.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. III" id="i.ix.iv-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.3" /> 

<p id="i.ix.iv-p1">1. Do we begin again to recommend ourselves - Is it
needful? Have I nothing but my own word to recommend me? St. Paul
chiefly here intends himself; though not excluding Timotheus, Titus, and
Silvanus. Unless we need - As if he had said, Do I indeed want such
recommendation?</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p2">2. Ye are our recommendatory letter - More convincing than
bare words could be. Written on our hearts - Deeply engraven there, and
plainly legible to all around us.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p3">3. Manifestly declared to be the letter of Christ - Which
he has formed and published to the world. Ministered by us - Whom he has
used herein as his instruments, therefore ye are our letter also.
Written not in tables of stone - Like the ten commandments. But in the
tender, living tables of their hearts - God having taken away the hearts
of stone and given them hearts of flesh.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p4">4. Such trust have we in God - That is, we trust in God
that this is so.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p5">5. Not that we are sufficient of ourselves - So much as to
think one good thought; much less, to convert sinners.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p6">6. Who also hath made us able ministers of the new covenant
- Of the new, evangelical dispensation. Not of the law, fitly called the
letter, from God's literally writing it on the two tables. But of the
Spirit - Of the gospel dispensation, which is written on the tables of
our hearts by the Spirit. For the letter - The law, the Mosaic
dispensation. Killeth - Seals in death those who still cleave to it. But
the Spirit - The gospel, conveying the Spirit to those who receive it.
Giveth life - Both spiritual and eternal: yea, if we adhere to the
literal sense even of the moral law, if we regard only the precept and
the sanction as they stand in themselves, not as they lead us to Christ,
they are doubtless a killing ordinance, and bind us down under the
sentence of death.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p7">7. And if the ministration of death - That is, the Mosaic
dispensation, which proves such to those who prefer it to the gospel,
the most considerable part of which was engraven on those two stones,
was attended with so great glory.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p8">8. The ministration of the Spirit - That is, the Christian
dispensation.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p9">9. The ministration of condemnation - Such the Mosaic
dispensation proved to all the Jews who rejected the gospel whereas
through the gospel (hence called the ministration of righteousness) God
both imputed and imparted righteousness to all believers. But how can
the moral law (which alone was engraven on stone) be the ministration of
condemnation, if it requires no more than a sincere obedience, such as
is proportioned to our infirm state? If this is sufficient to justify
us, then the law ceases to be a ministration of condemnation. It becomes
(flatly contrary to the apostle's doctrine) the ministration of
righteousness.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p10">10. It hath no glory in this respect, because of the glory
that excelleth - That is, none in comparison of this more excellent
glory. The greater light swallows up the less.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p11">11. That which remaineth - That dispensation which remains
to the end of the world; that spirit and life which remain forever.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p12">12. Having therefore this hope - Being fully persuaded of
this.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p13">13. And we do not act as Moses did, who put a veil over his
face - Which is to be understood with regard to his writings also. So
that the children of Israel could not look steadfastly to the end of
that dispensation which is now abolished - The end of this was Christ.
The whole Mosaic dispensation tended to, and terminated in, him; but the
Israelites had only a dim, wavering sight of him, of whom Moses spake in
an obscure, covert manner.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p14">14. The same veil remaineth on their understanding
unremoved - Not so much as folded back, (so the word implies,) so as to
admit a little, glimmering light. On the public reading of the Old
Testament - The veil is not now on the face of Moses or of his writings,
but on the reading of them, and on the heart of them that believe not.
Which is taken away in Christ - That is, from the heart of them that
truly believe on him.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p15">16. When it - Their heart. Shall turn to the Lord - To
Christ, by living faith. The veil is taken away - That very moment; and
they see, with the utmost clearness, how all the types and prophecies of
the law are fully accomplished in him.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p16">17. Now the Lord - Christ is that Spirit of the law whereof
I speak, to which the letter was intended to lead. And where the Spirit
of the Lord, Christ, is, there is liberty - Not the veil, the emblem of
slavery. There is liberty from servile fear, liberty from the guilt and
from the power of sin, liberty to behold with open face the glory of the
Lord.</p>

<p id="i.ix.iv-p17">18. And, accordingly, all we that believe in him, beholding
as in a glass - In the mirror of the gospel. The glory of the Lord - His
glorious love. Are transformed into the same image - Into the same love.
From one degree of this glory to another, in a manner worthy of his
almighty Spirit. What a beautiful contrast is here! Moses saw the glory
of the Lord, and it rendered his face so bright, that he covered it with
a veil; Israel not being able to bear the reflected light. We behold his
glory in the glass of his word, and our faces shine too; yet we veil
them not, but diffuse the lustre which is continually increasing, as we
fix the eye of our mind more and more steadfastly on his glory displayed
in the gospel.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="17.31%" prev="i.ix.iv" next="i.ix.vi" id="i.ix.v">
<h3 id="i.ix.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. IV" id="i.ix.v-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.4" /> 

<p id="i.ix.v-p1">1. Therefore having this ministry - Spoken of, chap. iii,
6. As we have received mercy - Have been mercifully supported in all our
trials. We faint not - We desist not in any degree from our glorious
enterprise.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p2">2. But have renounced - Set at open defiance. The hidden
things of shame - All things which men need to hide, or to be ashamed
of. Not walking in craftiness - Using no disguise, subtlety, guile. Nor
privily corrupting the pure word of God - By any additions or
alterations, or by attempting to accommodate it to the taste of the
hearers.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p3">3. But if our gospel also - As well as the law of
Moses.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p4">4. The God of this world - What a sublime and horrible
description of Satan! He is indeed the God of all that believe not, and
works in them with inconceivable energy. Hath blinded - Not only veiled,
the eye of their understanding. Illumination - Is properly the
reflection or propagation of light, from those who are already
enlightened, to others. Who is the image of God - Hence also we may
understand how great is the glory of Christ. He that sees the Son, sees
the Father in the face of Christ. The Son exactly exhibits the Father to
us.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p5">5. For - The fault is not in us, neither in the doctrine
they hear from us. We preach not ourselves - As able either to
enlighten, or pardon, or sanctify you. But Jesus Christ - As your only
wisdom, righteousness, sanctification. And ourselves your servants -
Ready to do the meanest offices. For Jesus' sake - Not for honour,
interest, or pleasure.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p6">6. For God hath shined in our hearts - The hearts of all
those whom the God of this world no longer blinds. God who is himself
our light; not only the author of light, but also the fountain of it. To
enlighten us with the knowledge of the glory of God - Of his glorious
love, and of his glorious image. In the face of Jesus Christ - Which
reflects his glory in another manner than the face of Moses did.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p7">7. But we - Not only the apostles, but all true believers.
Have this treasure - Of divine light, love, glory. In earthen vessels -
In frail, feeble, perishing bodies. He proceeds to show, that
afflictions, yea, death itself, are so far from hindering the
ministration of the Spirit, that they even further it, sharpen the
ministers, and increase the fruit. That the excellence of the power,
which works these in us, may undeniably appear to be of God.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p8">8. We are troubled, &amp;c. - The four articles in this
verse respect inward, the four in the next outward, afflictions. In each
clause the former part shows the "earthen vessels;" the latter, "the
excellence of the power." Not crushed - Not swallowed up in care and
anxiety. Perplexed - What course to take, but never despairing of his
power and love to carry us through.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p9">10. Always - Wherever we go. Bearing about in the body the
dying of the Lord Jesus - Continually expecting to lay down our lives
like him. That the life also of Jesus might be manifested in our body -
That we may also rise and be glorified like him.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p10">11. For we who yet live - Who are not yet killed for the
testimony of Jesus. Are always delivered unto death - Are perpetually in
the very jaws of destruction; which we willingly submit to, that we may
"obtain a better resurrection."</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p11">12. So then death worketh in us, but life in you - You live
in peace; we die daily. Yet - Living or dying, so long as we believe, we
cannot but speak.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p12">13. Having the same spirit of faith - Which animated the
saints of old; David, in particular, when he said, I believed, and
therefore have I spoken - That is, I trusted in God, and therefore he
hath put this song of praise in my mouth. We also speak - We preach the
gospel, even in the midst of affliction and death, because we believe
that God will raise us up from the dead, and will present us, ministers,
with you, all his members, "faultless before his presence with exceeding
joy." <scripRef passage="Psalm cxvi. 10" id="i.ix.v-p12.1" parsed="|Ps|116|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.116.10">Psalm cxvi, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p13">15. For all things - Whether adverse or prosperous. Are for
your sakes - For the profit of all that believe, as well as all that
preach. That the overflowing grace - Which continues you alive both in
soul and body. Might abound yet more through the thanksgiving of many -
For thanksgiving invites more: abundant grace.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p14">16. Therefore - Because of this grace, we faint not. The
outward man - The body. The inward man - The soul.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p15">17. Our light affliction - The beauty and sublimity of St.
Paul's expressions here, as descriptive of heavenly glory, opposed to
temporal afflictions, surpass all imagination, and cannot be preserved
in any translation or paraphrase, which after all must sink infinitely
below the astonishing original.</p>

<p id="i.ix.v-p16">18. The things that are seen - Men, money, things of earth.
The things that are not seen - God, grace, heaven.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="17.39%" prev="i.ix.v" next="i.ix.vii" id="i.ix.vi">
<h3 id="i.ix.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. V" id="i.ix.vi-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.5" /> 

<p id="i.ix.vi-p1">1. Our earthly house - Which is only a tabernacle, or tent,
not designed for a lasting habitation.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p2">2. Desiring to be clothed upon - This body, which is now
covered with flesh and blood, with the glorious house which is from
heaven. Instead of flesh and blood, which cannot enter heaven, the
rising body will be clothed or covered with what is analogous thereto,
but incorruptible and immortal. Macarius speaks largely of this.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p3">3. If being clothed - That is, with the image of God, while
we are in the body. We shall not be found naked - Of the wedding
garment.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p4">4. We groan being burdened - The apostle speaks with exact
propriety. A burden naturally expresses groans. And we are here burdened
with numberless afflictions, infirmities, temptations. Not that we would
be unclothed - Not that we desire to remain without a body. Faith does
not understand that philosophical contempt of what the wise Creator has
given. But clothed upon - With the glorious, immortal, incorruptible,
spiritual body. That what is mortal - This present mortal body. May be
swallowed up of life - Covered with that which lives forever.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p5">5. Now he that hath wrought us to this very thing - This
longing for immortality. Is God - For none but God, none less than the
Almighty, could have wrought this in us.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p6">6. Therefore we behave undauntedly - But most of all when
we have death in view; knowing that our greatest happiness lies beyond
the grave.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p7">7. For we cannot clearly see him in this life, wherein we
walk by faith only: an evidence, indeed, that necessarily implies a kind
of "seeing him who is invisible;" yet as far beneath what we shall have
in eternity, as it is above that of bare, unassisted reason.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p8">8. Present with the Lord - This demonstrates that the
happiness of the saints is not deferred till the resurrection.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p9">9. Therefore we are ambitious - The only ambition which has
place in a Christian. Whether present - In the body. Or absent - From
it.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p10">10. For we all - Apostles as well as other men, whether now
present in the body, or absent from it. Must appear - Openly, without
covering, where all hidden things will be revealed; probably the sins,
even of the faithful, which were forgiven long before. For many of their
good works, as their repentance, their revenge against sin, cannot other
wise appear. But this will be done at their own desire, without grief,
and without shame. According to what he hath done in the body, whether
good or evil - In the body he did either good or evil; in the body he is
recompensed accordingly.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p11">11. Knowing therefore the terror of the Lord, we the more
earnestly persuade men to seek his favour; and as God knoweth this, so,
I trust, ye know it in your own consciences.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p12">12. We do not say this, as if we thought there was any need
of again recommending ourselves to you, but to give you an occasion of
rejoicing and praising God, and to furnish you with an answer to those
false apostles who glory in appearance, but not in heart, being
condemned by their own conscience.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p13">13. For if we are transported beyond ourselves - Or at
least, appear so to others, treated of, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. v. 15-21" id="i.ix.vi-p13.1" parsed="|2Cor|5|15|5|21" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.5.15-2Cor.5.21">2 Cor. v, 15-21</scripRef>, speaking or writing with uncommon vehemence. It is to God -
He understands (if men do not) the emotion which himself inspires. If we
be sober - Treated of, chap. vi, 1-10. If I proceed in a more calm,
sedate manner. It is for your sakes - Even good men bear this, rather
than the other method, in their teachers. But these must obey God,
whoever is offended by it.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p14">14. For the love of Christ - To us, and our love to him.
Constraineth us - Both to the one and the other; beareth us on with such
a strong, steady, prevailing influence, as winds and tides exert when
they waft the vessel to its destined harbour. While we thus judge, that
if Christ died for all, then are all, even the best of men, naturally
dead - In a state of spiritual death, and liable to death eternal. For
had any man been otherwise, Christ had not needed to have died for
him.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p15">15. And that he died for all - That all might be saved.
That they who live - That all who live upon the earth. Should not
henceforth - From the moment they know him. Live unto themselves - Seek
their own honour, profit, pleasure. But unto him - In all righteousness
and true holiness.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p16">16. So that we from this time - That we knew the love of
Christ. Know no one - Neither ourselves, nor you, neither the rest of
the apostles, <scripRef passage="Gal. ii. 6" id="i.ix.vi-p16.1" parsed="|Gal|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.2.6">Gal. ii, 6</scripRef>, nor any other person. After the flesh - According to his
former state, country, descent, nobility, riches, power, wisdom. We fear
not the great. We regard not the rich or wise. We account not the least
less than ourselves. We consider all, only in order to save all. Who is
he that thus knows no one after the flesh? ln what land do these
Christians live? Yea, if we have known even Christ after the flesh - So
as to love him barely with a natural love, so as to glory in having
conversed with him on earth, so as to expect only temporal benefits from
him.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p17">17. Therefore if any one be in Christ - A true believer in
him. There is a new creation - Only the power that makes a world can
make a Christian. And when he is so created, the old things are passed
away - Of their own accord, even as snow in spring. Behold - The
present, visible, undeniable change! All things are become new - He has
new life, new senses, new faculties, new affections, new appetites, new
ideas and conceptions. His whole tenor of action and conversation is
new, and he lives, as it were, in a new world. God, men, the whole
creation, heaven, earth, and all therein, appear in a new light, and
stand related to him in a new manner, since he was created anew in
Christ Jesus.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p18">18. And all these new things are from God, considered under
this very notion, as reconciling us - The world, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. v. 19" id="i.ix.vi-p18.1" parsed="|2Cor|5|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.5.19">2 Cor. v, 19</scripRef>, to himself.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p19">19. Namely - The sum of which is, God - The whole Godhead,
but more eminently God the Father. Was in Christ, reconciling the world
- Which was before at enmity with God. To himself - So taking away that
enmity, which could no otherwise be removed than by the blood of the Son
of God.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p20">20. Therefore we are ambassadors for Christ-we beseech you
in Christ's stead - Herein the apostle might appear to some "transported
beyond himself." In general he uses a more calm, sedate kind of
exhortation, as in the beginning of the next chapter. What unparalleled
condescension and divinely tender mercies are displayed in this verse!
Did the judge ever beseech a condemned criminal to accept of pardon?
Does the creditor ever beseech a ruined debtor to receive an acquittance
in full? Yet our almighty Lord, and our eternal Judge, not only
vouchsafes to offer these blessings, but invites us, entreats us, and,
with the most tender importunity, solicits us, not to reject them.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vi-p21">21. He made him a sin offering, who knew no sin - A
commendation peculiar to Christ. For us - Who knew no righteousness, who
were inwardly and outwardly nothing but sin; who must have been consumed
by the divine justice, had not this atonement been made for our sins.
That we might be made the righteousness of God through him - Might
through him be invested with that righteousness, first imputed to us,
then implanted in us, which is in every sense the righteousness of
God.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="17.52%" prev="i.ix.vi" next="i.ix.viii" id="i.ix.vii">
<h3 id="i.ix.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. VI" id="i.ix.vii-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.6" /> 

<p id="i.ix.vii-p1">1. We then not only beseech, but as fellow-labourers with
you, who are working out your own salvation, do also exhort you, not to
receive the grace of God - Which we have been now describing. In vain -
We receive it by faith; and not in vain, if we add to this, persevering
holiness.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p2">2. For he saith - The sense is, As of old there was a
particular time wherein God was pleased to pour out his peculiar
blessing, so there is now. And this is the particular time: this is a
time of peculiar blessing. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xlix. 8" id="i.ix.vii-p2.1" parsed="|Isa|49|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.49.8">Isaiah
xlix, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p3">3. Giving, as far as in us lies, no offense, that the
ministry be not blamed on our account.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p4">4. But approving ourselves as the ministers of God - Such
as his ministers ought to be. In much patience - Shown,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ix.vii-p5">1. In afflictions, necessities, distresses -
All which are general terms.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ix.vii-p6">2. In stripes, imprisonments, tumults - Which
are particular sorts of affliction, necessity, distress</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.ix.vii-p7">3. In labours, watchings, fastings -
Voluntarily endured. All these are expressed in the plural number, to
denote a variety of them. In afflictions, several ways to escape may
appear, though none without difficulty in necessities, one only, and
that a difficult one; in distresses, none at all appears.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p8">5. In tumults - The Greek word implies such attacks as a
man cannot stand against, but which bear him hither and thither by
violence.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p9">6. By prudence - Spiritual divine; not what the world terms
so. Worldly prudence is the practical use of worldly wisdom: divine
prudence is the due exercise of grace, making spiritual understanding go
as far as possible. By love unfeigned - The chief fruit of the
Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p10">7. By the convincing and converting power of God -
Accompanying his word; and also attesting it by divers miracles. By the
armour of righteousness on the right hand and the left - That is, on all
sides; the panoply or whole armour of God.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p11">8. By honour and dishonour - When we are present. By evil
report and good report - When we are absent. Who could bear honour and
good report, were it not balanced by dishonour? As deceivers - Artful,
designing men. So the world represents all true ministers of Christ. Yet
true - Upright, sincere, in the sight of God.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p12">9. As unknown - For the world knoweth us not, as it knew
him not. Yet well known - To God, and to those who are the seals of our
ministry. As dying, yet behold - Suddenly, unexpectedly, God interposes,
and we live.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p13">10. As sorrowing - For our own manifold imperfections, and
for the sins and sufferings of our brethren. Yet always rejoicing - In
present peace, love, power, and a sure hope of future glory. As having
nothing, yet possessing all things - For all things are ours, if we are
Christ's. What a magnificence of thought is this!</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p14">11. From the praise of the Christian ministry, which he
began chap. ii, 14, he now draws his affectionate exhortation. O ye
Corinthians - He seldom uses this appellation. But it has here a
peculiar force. Our mouth is opened toward you - With uncommon freedom,
because our heart is enlarged - In tenderness.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p15">12. Ye are not straitened in us - Our heart is wide enough
to receive you all. But ye are straitened in your own bowels - Your
hearts are shut up, and so not capable of the blessings ye might
enjoy.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p16">13. Now for a recompence of the same - Of my parental
tenderness. I speak as to my children - I ask nothing hard or grievous.
Be ye also enlarged - Open your hearts, first to God, and then to us, so
chap. viii, 5, that God may "dwell in you," <scripRef passage="2 Cor. vi. 16; vii. 1" id="i.ix.vii-p16.1" parsed="|2Cor|6|16|0|0;|2Cor|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.6.16 Bible:2Cor.7.1">2 Cor. vi, 16; vii, 1</scripRef>; and that ye may "receive us," chap. vii, 2.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p17">14. Be not unequally yoked with unbelievers - Christians
with Jews or heathens. The apostle particularly speaks of marriage. But
the reasons he urges equally hold against any needless intimacy with
them. Of the five questions that follow, the three former contain the
argument; the two latter, the conclusion.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p18">15. What concord hath Christ - Whom ye serve. With Belial -
To whom they belong.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p19">16. What agreement hath the temple of God with idols - If
God would not endure idols in any part of the land wherein he dwelt, how
much less, under his own roof! He does not say, with the temple of
idols, for idols do not dwell in their worshippers. As God hath said -
To his ancient church, and in them to all the Israel of God. I will
dwell in them, and walk in them - The former signifying his perpetual
presence; the latter, his operation. And I will be to them a God, and
they shall be to me a people - The sum of the whole gospel covenant. <scripRef passage="Lev. xxvi. 11" id="i.ix.vii-p19.1" parsed="|Lev|26|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.26.11">Lev. xxvi, 11</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p20">17. Touch not the unclean person - Keep at the utmost
distance from him. And I will receive you - Into my house and family. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lii. 11" id="i.ix.vii-p20.1" parsed="|Isa|52|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.52.11">Isaiah lii, 11</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Zeph. iii. 19, 20" id="i.ix.vii-p20.2" parsed="|Zeph|3|19|3|20" osisRef="Bible:Zeph.3.19-Zeph.3.20">Zephaniah iii, 19,
20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ix.vii-p21">18. And ye shall be to me for sons and for daughters, saith
the Lord Almighty - The promise made to Solomon, <scripRef passage="1 Chr. xxviii. 6" id="i.ix.vii-p21.1" parsed="|1Chr|28|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.28.6">1 Chr. xxviii, 6</scripRef>, is here applied to all believers; as the promise made
particularly to Josh. is applied to them, <scripRef passage="Heb. xiii. 5" id="i.ix.vii-p21.2" parsed="|Heb|13|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.13.5">Heb. xiii, 5</scripRef>. Who can express the worth, who can conceive the dignity, of
this divine adoption? Yet it belongs to all who believe the gospel, who
have faith in Christ. They have access to the Almighty; such free and
welcome access, as a beloved child to an indulgent father. To him they
may fly for aid in every difficulty, and from him obtain a supply in all
their wants. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xliii. 6" id="i.ix.vii-p21.3" parsed="|Isa|43|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.43.6">Isaiah xliii,
6</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="17.61%" prev="i.ix.vii" next="i.ix.ix" id="i.ix.viii">
<h3 id="i.ix.viii-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. VII" id="i.ix.viii-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.7" /> 

<p id="i.ix.viii-p1">1. Let us cleanse ourselves - This is the latter part of
the exhortation, which was proposed, chap. vi, 1, and resumed, chap. vi,
14. From all pollution of the flesh - All outward sin. And of the spirit
- All inward. Yet let us not rest in negative religion, but perfect
holiness - Carrying it to the height in all its branches, and enduring
to the end in the loving fear of God, the sure foundation of all
holiness.</p>

<p id="i.ix.viii-p2">2. Receive us - The sum of what is said in this, as well as
in the tenth and following chapters. We have hurt no man - In his
person. We have corrupted no man - In his principles. We have defrauded
no man - Of his property. In this he intimates likewise the good he had
done them, but with the utmost modesty, as it were not looking upon
it.</p>

<p id="i.ix.viii-p3">3. I speak not to condemn you - Not as if I accused you of
laying this to my charge. I am so far from thinking so unkindly of you,
that ye are in our hearts, to live and die with you - That is, I could
rejoice to spend all my days with you.</p>

<p id="i.ix.viii-p4">4. I am filled with comfort - Of this he treats, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. vii. 6" id="i.ix.viii-p4.1" parsed="|2Cor|7|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.7.6">2 Cor. vii, 6</scripRef>, &amp;c.; of his joy, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. vii. 7" id="i.ix.viii-p4.2" parsed="|2Cor|7|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.7.7">2 Cor. vii, 7</scripRef>, &amp;c.; of both, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. vii. 13" id="i.ix.viii-p4.3" parsed="|2Cor|7|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.7.13">2 Cor. vii,
13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ix.viii-p5">5. Our flesh - That is, we ourselves. Had no rest from
without - From the heathens. Were fightings - Furious and cruel
oppositions. From within - From our brethren. Were fears - Lest they
should be seduced.</p>

<p id="i.ix.viii-p6">7. Your earnest desire - To rectify what had been amiss.
Your grief - For what had offended God, and troubled me.</p>

<p id="i.ix.viii-p7">8. I did repent - That is, I felt a tender sorrow for
having grieved you, till I saw the happy effect of it.</p>

<p id="i.ix.viii-p8">10. The sorrow of the world - Sorrow that arises from
worldly considerations. Worketh death - Naturally tends to work or
occasion death, temporal, spiritual, and eternal.</p>

<p id="i.ix.viii-p9">11. How great diligence it wrought in you - Shown in all
the following particulars. Yea, clearing of yourselves - Some had been
more, some less, faulty; whence arose these various affections. Hence
their apologizing and indignation, with respect to themselves; their
fear and desire, with respect to the apostle; their zeal and revenge,
with respect to the offender, yea, and themselves also. Clearing of
yourselves - From either sharing in, or approving of, his sin.
Indignation - That ye had not immediately corrected the offender. Fear -
Of God's displeasure, or lest I should come with a rod. Vehement desire
- To see me again. Zeal - For the glory of God, and the soul of that
sinner. Yea, revenge - Ye took a kind of holy revenge upon yourselves,
being scarce able to forgive yourselves. In all things ye - As a church.
Have approved yourselves to be pure - That is, free from blame, since ye
received my letter.</p>

<p id="i.ix.viii-p10">12. It was not only, or chiefly, for the sake of the
incestuous person, or of his father; but to show my care over you.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="17.66%" prev="i.ix.viii" next="i.ix.x" id="i.ix.ix">
<h3 id="i.ix.ix-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. VIII" id="i.ix.ix-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.8" /> 

<p id="i.ix.ix-p1">1. We declare to you the grace of God - Which evidently
appeared by this happy effect.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p2">2. In a great trial of affliction - Being continually
persecuted, harassed, and plundered.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p3">4. Praying us with much entreaty - Probably St. Paul had
lovingly admonished them not to do beyond their power.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p4">5. And not as we hoped - That is, beyond all we could hope.
They gave themselves to us, by the will of God - In obedience to his
will, to be wholly directed by us.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p5">6. As he had begun - When he was with you before.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p6">9. For ye know - And this knowledge is the true source of
love. The grace - The most sincere, most free, and most abundant love.
He became poor - In becoming man, in all his life; in his death. Rich -
In the favour and image of God.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p7">12. A man - Every believer. Is accepted - With God.
According to what he hath - And the same rule holds universally. Whoever
acknowledges himself to be a vile, guilty sinner, and, in consequence of
this acknowledgment, flies for refuge to the wounds of a crucified
saviour, and relies on his merits alone for salvation, may in every
circumstance of life apply this indulgent declaration to himself.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p8">14. That their abundance - If need should so require. May
be - At another time. A supply to your want: that there may be an
equality - No want on one side, no superfluity on the other. It may
likewise have a further meaning:-that as the temporal bounty of the
Corinthians did now supply the temporal wants of their poor brethren in
Judea, so the prayers of these might be a means of bringing down many
spiritual blessings on their benefactors: so that all the spiritual
wants of the one might be amply supplied; all the temporal of the
other.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p9">15. As it is written, He that had gathered the most had
nothing over; and he that had gathered the least did not lack - That is,
in which that scripture is in another sense fulfilled. <scripRef passage="Exod. xvi. 18" id="i.ix.ix-p9.1" parsed="|Exod|16|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16.18">Exod. xvi, 18</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p10">17. Being more forward - Than to need it, though he
received it well.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p11">18. We - I and Timothy. The brother - The ancients
generally supposed this was St. Luke. Whose praise - For faithfully
dispensing the gospel, is through all the churches.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p12">19. He was appointed by the churches - Of Macedonia. With
this gift - Which they were carrying from Macedonia to Jerusalem. For
the declaration of our ready mind - That of Paul and his
fellow-traveler, ready to be the servants of all.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p13">22. With them - With Titus and Luke. Our brother - Perhaps
Apollos.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p14">23. My partner - In my cares and labours. The glory of
Christ - Signal instruments of advancing his glory.</p>

<p id="i.ix.ix-p15">24. Before the churches - Present by their messengers.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="17.70%" prev="i.ix.ix" next="i.ix.xi" id="i.ix.x">
<h3 id="i.ix.x-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. IX" id="i.ix.x-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.9" /> 

<p id="i.ix.x-p1">1. To write to you - Largely.</p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p2">2. I boast to them of Macedonia - With whom he then
was.</p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p3">3. I have sent the above mentioned brethren before me.</p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p4">5. Spoken of before - By me, to the Macedonians. Not as a
matter of covetousness - As wrung by importunity from covetous
persons.</p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p5">6. He that soweth sparingly shall reap sparingly; he that
soweth bountifully shall reap bountifully - A general rule. God will
proportion the reward to the work, and the temper whence it
proceeds.</p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p6">7. Of necessity - Because he cannot tell how to refuse.</p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p7">8. How remarkable are these words! Each is loaded with
matter and increases all the way it goes. All grace - Every kind of
blessing. That ye may abound to every good work - God gives us
everything, that we may do good therewith, and so receive more
blessings. All things in this life, even rewards, are, to the faithful,
seeds in order to a future harvest. <scripRef passage="Prov. xxii. 9" id="i.ix.x-p7.1" parsed="|Prov|22|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.22.9">Prov. xxii, 9</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p8">9. He hath scattered abroad - (A generous word.) With a
full hand, without any anxious thought which way each grain falls. His
righteousness - His beneficence, with the blessed effects of it.
Remaineth forever - Unexhausted, God still renewing his store. <scripRef passage="Psalm cxii. 9" id="i.ix.x-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|112|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.112.9">Psalm cxii, 9</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p9">10. And he who supplieth seed - Opportunity and ability to
help others. And bread - All things needful for your own souls and
bodies. Will continually supply you with that seed, yea, multiply it to
you more and more. And increase the fruits of your righteousness - The
happy effects of your love to God and man. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lv. 10" id="i.ix.x-p9.1" parsed="|Isa|55|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.55.10">Isaiah lv, 10</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p10">11. Which worketh by us thanksgiving to God - Both from us
who distribute, and them who receive, your bounty.</p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p11">13. Your avowed subjection - Openly testified by your
actions. To all men - Who stand in need of it.</p>

<p id="i.ix.x-p12">15. His unspeakable gift - His outward and inward
blessings, the number and excellence of which cannot be uttered.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="17.74%" prev="i.ix.x" next="i.ix.xii" id="i.ix.xi">
<h3 id="i.ix.xi-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. X" id="i.ix.xi-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.10" /> 

<p id="i.ix.xi-p1">1. Now I Paul myself - - A strongly emphatical expression.
Who when present am base among you - So, probably, some of the false
teachers affirmed. Copying after the meekness and gentleness of Christ,
entreat - Though I might command you.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p2">2. Do not constrain me when present to be bold - To exert
my apostolical authority. Who think of us as walking after the flesh -
As acting in a cowardly or crafty manner.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p3">3. Though we walk in the flesh - In mortal bodies, and,
consequently, are not free from human weakness. Yet we do not war -
Against the world and the devil. After the flesh - By any carnal or
worldly methods. Though the apostle here, and in several other parts of
this epistle, speaks in the plural number, for the sake of modesty and
decency, yet he principally means himself. On him were these reflections
thrown, and it is his own authority which he is vindicating.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p4">4. For the weapons of our warfare - Those we use in this
war. Are not carnal - But spiritual, and therefore mighty to the
throwing down of strong holds - Of all the difficulties which men or
devils can raise in our way. Though faith and prayer belong also to the
Christian armour, <scripRef passage="Eph. vi. 15" id="i.ix.xi-p4.1" parsed="|Eph|6|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.6.15">Eph. vi,
15</scripRef>, &amp;c., yet the word of God seems to be here chiefly
intended.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p5">5. Destroying all vain reasonings, and every high thing
which exalteth itself - As a wall or rampart. Against the knowledge of
God, and bringing every thought - Or, rather, faculty of the mind. Into
captivity to the obedience of Christ - Those evil reasonings are
destroyed. The mind itself, being overcome and taken captive, lays down
all authority of its own, and entirely gives itself up to perform, for
the time to come, to Christ its conqueror the obedience of faith.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p6">6. Being in readiness to avenge all disobedience - Not only
by spiritual censure, but miraculous punishments. When your obedience is
fulfilled - When the sound part of you has given proof of your

obedience, so that I am in no danger of punishing the innocent with the
guilty.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p7">7. Do ye look at the outward appearance of things - Does
any of you judge of a minister of Christ by his person, or any outward
circumstance? Let him again think this of himself - Let him learn it
from his own reflection, before I convince him by a severer method.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p8">8. I should not be ashamed - As having said more than I
could make good.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p9">9. I say this, that I may not seem to terrify you by
letters - Threatening more than I can perform.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p10">10. His bodily presence is weak - His stature, says St.
Chrysostom, was low, his body crooked, and his head bald.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p11">12. For we presume not - A strong irony. To equal ourselves
- As partners of the same office. Or to compare ourselves - As partakers
of the same labour. They among themselves limiting themselves - Choosing
and limiting their provinces according to their own fancy.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p12">13. But we will not, like them, boastingly extend ourselves
beyond our measure, but according to the measure of the province which
God hath allotted us - To me, in particular, as the apostle of the
gentiles. A measure which reaches even unto you - God allotted to each
apostle his province, and the measure or bounds thereof.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p13">14. We are come even to you - By a gradual, regular
process, having taken the intermediate places in our way, in preaching
the gospel of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p14">15. Having hope, now your faith is increased - So that you
can the better spare us. To be enlarged by you abundantly - That is,
enabled by you to go still further.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xi-p15">16. In the regions beyond you - To the west and south,
where the gospel had not yet been preached.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="17.80%" prev="i.ix.xi" next="i.ix.xiii" id="i.ix.xii">
<h3 id="i.ix.xii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. XI" id="i.ix.xii-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.11" /> 

<p id="i.ix.xii-p1">1. I wish ye would bear - So does he pave the way for what
might otherwise have given offense. With my folly - Of commending
myself; which to many may appear folly; and really would be so, were it
not on this occasion absolutely necessary.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p2">2. For - The cause of his seeming folly is expressed in
this and the following verse; the cause why they should bear with him, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. xi. 4" id="i.ix.xii-p2.1" parsed="|2Cor|11|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.11.4">2 Cor. xi, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p3">3. But I fear - Love is full of these fears. Lest as the
serpent - A most apposite comparison. Deceived Eve - Simple, ignorant of
evil. By his subtilty - Which is in the highest degree dangerous to such
a disposition. So your minds - We might therefore be tempted, even if
there were no sin in us. Might be corrupted - Losing their virginal
purity. From the simplicity that is in Christ - That simplicity which is
lovingly intent on him alone, seeking no other person or thing.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p4">4. If indeed - Any could show you another saviour, a more
powerful Spirit, a better gospel. Ye might well bear with him - But this
is impossible.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p5">6. If I am unskilful in speech - If I speak in a plain,
unadorned way, like an unlearned person. So the Greek word properly
signifies.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p6">7. Have I committed an offense - Will any turn this into an
objection? In humbling myself - To work at my trade. That ye might be
exalted - To be children of God.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p7">8. I spoiled other churches - I, as it were, took the
spoils of them: it is a military term. Taking wages (or pay, another
military word) of them - When I came to you at first. And when I was
present with you, and wanted - My work not quite supplying my
necessities. I was chargeable to no man - Of Corinth.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p8">9. For - I choose to receive help from the poor
Macedonians, rather than the rich Corinthians! Were the poor in all ages
more generous than the rich?</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p9">10. This my boasting shall not be stopped - For I will
receive nothing from you.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p10">11. Do I refuse to receive anything of you, because I love
you not? God knoweth that is not the case.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p11">12. Who desire any occasion - To censure me. That wherein
they boast, they may be found even as we - They boasted of being
"burdensome to no man." But it was a vain boast in them, though not in
the apostle.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p12">14. Satan himself is transformed - Uses to transform
himself; to put on the fairest appearances.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p13">15. Therefore it is no great, no strange, thing; whose end,
notwithstanding all their disguises, shall be according to their
works.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p14">16. I say again - He premises a new apology to this new
commendation of himself. Let no man think me a fool - Let none think I
do this without the utmost necessity. But if any do think me foolish
herein, yet bear with my folly.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p15">17. I speak not after the Lord - Not by an express command
from him; though still under the direction of his Spirit. But as it were
foolishly - In such a manner as many may think foolish.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p16">18. After the flesh - That is, in external things.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p17">19. Being wise - A beautiful irony.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p18">20. For ye suffer - Not only the folly, but the gross
abuses, of those false apostles. If a man enslave you - Lord it over you
in the most arbitrary manner. If he devour you - By his exorbitant
demands; not - withstanding his boast of not being burdensome. If he
take from you - By open violence. If he exalt himself - By the most
unbounded self-commendation. If he smite you on the face - (A very
possible case,) under pretense of divine zeal.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p19">21. I speak with regard to reproach, as though we had been
weak - I say, "Bear with me," even on supposition that the weakness be
real which they reproach me with.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p20">22. Are they Hebrews, Israelites, the seed of Abraham -
These were the heads on which they boasted.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p21">23. I am more so than they. In deaths often - Surrounding
me in the most dreadful forms.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p22">24. Five times I received from the Jews forty stripes save
one - Which was the utmost that the law allowed. With the Roman he
sometimes pleaded his privilege as a Roman; but from the Jews he
suffered all things.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p23">25. Thrice I have been shipwrecked - Before his voyage to
Rome. In the deep - Probably floating on some part of the vessel.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p24">27. In cold and nakedness - Having no place where to lay my
head; no convenient raiment to cover me; yet appearing before noble-men,
governors, kings; and not being ashamed.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p25">28. Beside the things which are from without - Which I
suffer on the account of others; namely, the care of all the churches -
A more modest expression than if he had said, the care of the whole
church. All - Even those I have not seen in the flesh. St. Peter himself
could not have said this in so strong a sense.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p26">29. Who - So he had not only the care of the churches, but
of every person therein. Is weak, and I am not weak - By sympathy, as
well as by condescension. Who is offended - Hindered in, or turned out
of, the good way. And I burn not - Being pained as though I had fire in
my bosom.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p27">30. I will glory of the things that concern my infirmities
- Of what shows my weakness, rather than my strength.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p28">32. The governor under Aretas - King of Arabia and Syria of
which Damascus was a chief city, willing to oblige the Jews, kept the
city - Setting guards at all the gates day and night.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xii-p29">33. Through a window - Of an house which stood on the city
wall.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="17.89%" prev="i.ix.xii" next="i.ix.xiv" id="i.ix.xiii">
<h3 id="i.ix.xiii-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. XII" id="i.ix.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.12" /> 

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p1">1. It is not expedient - Unless on so pressing occasion.
Visions are seen; Revelations, heard.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p2">2. I knew a man in Christ - That is, a Christian. It is
plain from <scripRef passage="2 Cor. xii. 6, 7" id="i.ix.xiii-p2.1" parsed="|2Cor|12|6|12|7" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.12.6-2Cor.12.7">2 Cor. xii, 6,
7</scripRef>, that he means himself, though in modesty he speaks as of a
third person. Whether in the body or out of the body I know not - It is
equally possible with God to present distant things to the imagination
in the body, as if the soul were absent from it, and present with them;
or to transport both soul and body for what time he pleases to heaven;
or to transport the soul only thither for a season, and in the mean time
to preserve the body fit for its re- entrance. But since the apostle
himself did not know whether his soul was in the body, or whether one or
both were actually in heaven, it would be vain curiosity for us to
attempt determining it. The third heaven - Where God is; far above the
aerial and the starry heaven. Some suppose it was here the apostle was
let into the mystery of the future state of the church; and received his
orders to turn from the Jews and go to the gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p3">3. Yea, I knew such a man - That at another time.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p4">4. He was caught up into paradise - The seat of happy
spirits in their separate state, between death and the resurrection.
Things which it is not possible for man to utter - Human language being
incapable of expressing them. Here he anticipated the joyous rest of the
righteous that die in the Lord. But this rapture did not precede, but
follow after, his being caught up to the third heaven: a strong
intimation that he must first discharge his mission, and then enter into
glory. And beyond all doubt, such a foretaste of it served to strengthen
him in all his after trials, when he could call to mind the very joy
that was prepared for him.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p5">5. Of such an one I will - I might, glory; but I will not
glory of myself - As considered in myself.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p6">6. For if I should resolve to glory - Referring to, I might
glory of such a glorious Revelation. I should not be a fool - That is,
it could not justly be accounted folly to relate the naked truth. But I
forbear - I speak sparingly of these things, for fear any one should
think too highly of me - O where is this fear now to be found? Who is
afraid of this?</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p7">7. There was given me - By the wise and gracious providence
of God. A thorn in the flesh - A visitation more painful than any thorn
sticking in the flesh. A messenger or angel of Satan to buffet me -
Perhaps both visibly and invisibly; and the word in the original
expresses the present, as well as the past, time. All kinds of
affliction had befallen the apostle. Yet none of those did he deprecate.
But here he speaks of one, as above all the rest, one that macerated him
with weakness, and by the pain and ignominy of it prevented his being
lifted up mere, or, at least, not less, than the most vehement head ache
could have done; which many of the ancients say he laboured under. St.
Paul seems to have had a fresh fear of these buffetings every moment,
when he so frequently represses himself in his boasting, though it was
extorted from him by the utmost necessity.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p8">8. Concerning this - He had now forgot his being lifted up.
I besought the Lord thrice - As our Lord besought his Father.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p9">9. But he said to me - ln answer to my third request. My
grace is sufficient for thee - How tender a repulse! We see there may be
grace where there is the quickest sense of pain. My strength is more
illustriously displayed by the weakness of the instrument. Therefore I
will glory in my weaknesses rather than my Revelations, that the
strength of Christ may rest upon me - The Greek word properly means, may
cover me all over like a tent. We ought most willingly to accept
whatever tends to this end, however contrary to flesh and blood.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p10">10. Weaknesses - Whether proceeding from Satan or men. For
when I am weak - Deeply conscious of my weakness, then does the strength
of Christ rest upon me.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p11">11. Though I am nothing - Of myself.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p12">14. The third time - Having been disappointed twice. I seek
not yours - Your goods. But you - Your souls.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p13">15. I will gladly spend - All I have. And be spent -
Myself.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p14">16. But some may object, though I did not burden you,
though I did not take anything of you myself, yet being crafty I caught
you with guile - I did secretly by my messengers what I would not do
openly, or in person.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p15">17. I answer this lying accusation by appealing to plain
fact. Did I make a gain of you by Titus - Or any other of my messengers?
You know the contrary. It should be carefully observed, that St. Paul
does not allow, but absolutely denies, that he had caught them with
guile; so that the common plea for guile, which has been often drawn
from this text, is utterly without foundation.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p16">18. I desired Titus - To go to you.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p17">19. Think ye that we again excuse ourselves - That I speak
this for my own sake? No. I speak all this for your sakes.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiii-p18">21. Who had sinned before - My last coming to Corinth.
Uncleanness - Of married persons. Lasciviousness - Against nature.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="17.98%" prev="i.ix.xiii" next="i.x" id="i.ix.xiv">
<h3 id="i.ix.xiv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Cor. XIII" id="i.ix.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|2Cor|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.13" /> 

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p1">1. I am coming this third time - He had been coming twice
before, though he did not actually come.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p2">2. All the rest - Who have since then sinned in any of
these kinds. I will not spare - I will severely punish them.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p3">4. He was crucified through weakness - Through the
impotence of human nature. We also are weak with him - We appear weak
and despicable by partaking of the same sufferings for his sake. But we
shall live with him - Being raised from the dead. By the power of God in
you - By that divine energy which is now in every believer, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. xiii. 5" id="i.ix.xiv-p3.1" parsed="|2Cor|13|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.13.5">2 Cor. xiii, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p4">5. Prove yourselves - Whether ye are such as can, or such
as cannot, bear the test - This is the proper meaning of the word which
we translate, reprobates. Know ye not yourselves, that Jesus Christ is
in you - All Christian believers know this, by the witness and by the
fruit of his Spirit. Some translate the words, Jesus Christ is among
you; that is, in the church of Corinth; and understand them of the
miraculous gifts and the power of Christ which attended the censures of
the apostle.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p5">6. And I trust ye shall know - By proving yourselves, not
by putting my authority to the proof.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p6">7. I pray God that ye may do no evil - To give me occasion
of showing my apostolical power. I do not desire to appear approved - By
miraculously punishing you. But that ye may do that which is good,
though we should be as reprobates - Having no occasion to give that
proof of our apostleship.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p7">8. For we can do nothing against the truth - Neither
against that which is just and right, nor against those who walk
according to the truth of the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p8">9. For we rejoice when we are weak - When we appear so,
having no occasion to show our apostolic power. And this we wish, even
your perfection - In the faith that worketh by love.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p9">11. Be perfect - Aspire to the highest degree of holiness.
Be of good comfort - Filled with divine consolation. Be of one mind -
Desire, labour, pray for it, to the utmost degree that is possible.</p>

<p id="i.ix.xiv-p10">13. The grace - Or favour. Of our Lord Jesus Christ - By
which alone we can come to the Father. And the love of God - Manifested
to you, and abiding in you. And the communion - Or fellowship. Of the
Holy Ghost - In all his gifts and graces. It is with great reason that
this comprehensive and instructive blessing is pronounced at the close
of our solemn assemblies; and it is a very indecent thing to see so many
quitting them, or getting into postures of remove, before this short
sentence can be ended. How often have we heard this awful benediction
pronounced! Let us study it more and more, that we may value it
proportionably; that we may either deliver or receive it with a becoming
reverence, with eyes and hearts lifted up to God, "who giveth the
blessing out of Zion, and life forevermore."</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE GALATIANS" progress="18.03%" prev="i.ix.xiv" next="i.x.i" id="i.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gal" id="i.x-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.x-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE GALATIANS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Galations" progress="18.03%" prev="i.x" next="i.x.ii" id="i.x.i">

<p id="i.x.i-p1">THIS epistle is not written, as most of St. Paul's are, to
the Christians of a particular city, but to those of a whole country in
Asia Minor, the metropolis of which was Ancyra. These readily embraced
the gospel; but, after St. Paul had left them, certain men came among
them, who (like those mentioned, <scripRef passage="Acts xv. 1" id="i.x.i-p1.1" parsed="|Acts|15|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.15.1">Acts xv,
1</scripRef>.) taught that it was necessary to be circumcised, and to
keep the Mosaic law. They affirmed, that all the other apostles taught
thus; that St. Paul was inferior to them; and that even he sometimes
practiced and recommended the law, though at other times he opposed it.
The first part, therefore, of this epistle is spent in vindicating
himself and his doctrine; proving,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.i-p2">1. That he had it immediately from Christ
himself; and that he was not inferior to the other apostles.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.i-p3">2. That it was the very same which the other
apostles preached. And,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.i-p4">3. That his practice was consistent with his
doctrine. The second contains proofs, drawn from the Old Testament, that
the law and all its ceremonies were abolished by Christ. The third
contains practical inferences, closed with his usual benediction. To be
a little more distinct - This epistle contains,</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.x.i-p5">I. The inscription, C.i. 1-5</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.x.i-p6">II. The calling the Galatians back to the
true gospel; wherein he</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.x.i-p7">1. Reproves them for leaving it, 6-10</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.x.i-p8">2. Asserts the authority of the gospel he had
preached, who,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.i-p9">1. Of a persecutor was made an apostle, by an
immediate call from heaven, 11-17</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.i-p10">2. Was no way inferior to Peter himself,
18-C.ii. 21</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.i-p11">3. Defends justification by faith, and again
reproves the Galatians, C.iii. 1-iv. 11</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.i-p12">4. Explains the same thing by an allegory
taken out of the law itself, 12-31</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.i-p13">5. Exhorts them to maintain their liberty,
C.v.1-12 warns them not to abuse it, and admonishes them to walk not
after the flesh, but after the Spirit,. 13-C.vi. 10</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.x.i-p14">III. The conclusion, 11-18</p>
<h2 id="i.x.i-p14.1">GALATIANS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="18.06%" prev="i.x.i" next="i.x.iii" id="i.x.ii">
<h3 id="i.x.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gal. I" id="i.x.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Gal|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.1" /> 

<p id="i.x.ii-p1">1. Paul, an apostle - Here it was necessary for St. Paul to
assert his authority; otherwise he is very modest in the use of this
title. He seldom mentions it when he mentions others in the salutations
with himself, as in the Epistles to the Philippians and Thessalonians;
or when he writes about secular affairs, as in that to Philemon; nor yet
in writing to the Hebrews because he was not properly their apostle. Not
of men - Not commissioned from them, but from God the Father. Neither by
man - Neither by any man as an instrument, but by Jesus Christ. Who
raised him from the dead - Of which it was the peculiar business of an
apostle to bear witness.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p2">2. And all the brethren -- who agree with me in what I now
write.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p3">4. That he might deliver us from the present evil world -
From the guilt, wickedness, and misery wherein it is involved, and from
its vain and foolish customs and pleasures. According to the will of God
- Without any merit of ours. St. Paul begins most of his epistles with
thanksgiving; but, writing to the Galatians, he alters his style, and
first sets down his main proposition, That by the merits of Christ
alone, giving himself for our sins, we are justified: neither does he
term them, as he does others, either saints," elect," or churches of
God."</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p4">5. To whom be glory - For this his gracious will.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p5">6. I marvel that ye are removed so soon - After my leaving
you. From him who called you by the grace of Christ - His gracious
gospel, and his gracious power.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p6">7. Which, indeed, is not properly another gospel. For what
ye have now received is no gospel at all; it is not glad, but heavy,
tidings, as setting your acceptance with God upon terms impossible to be
performed. But there are some that trouble you - The same word occurs, <scripRef passage="Acts xv. 24" id="i.x.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Acts|15|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.15.24">Acts xv, 24</scripRef>. And would - If they were able. Subvert or overthrow the
gospel of Christ - The better to effect which, they suggest, that the
other apostles, yea, and I myself, insist upon the observance of the
law.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p7">8. But if we - I and all the apostles. Or an angel from
heaven - If it were possible. Preach another gospel, let him be accursed
- Cut off from Christ and God.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p8">9. As - He speaks upon mature deliberation; after pausing,
it seems, between the two verses. We - I and the brethren who are with
me. Have said before - Many times, in effect, if not in terms. So I say
- All those brethren knew the truth of the gospel. St. Paul knew the
Galatians had received the true gospel.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p9">10. For - He adds the reason why he speaks so confidently.
Do I now satisfy men - Is this what I aim at in preaching or writing? If
I still - Since I was an apostle. Pleased men - Studied to please them;
if this were my motive of action; nay, if I did in fact please the men
who know not God. I should not be the servant of Christ - Hear this, all
ye who vainly hope to keep in favour both with God and with the
world!</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p10">11. But I certify you, brethren -- he does not till now give
them even this appellation. That the gospel which was preached by me
among you is not according to man - Not from man, not by man, not suited
to the taste of man.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p11">12. For neither did I receive it - At once. Nor was I
taught it - Slowly and gradually, by any man. But by the Revelation of
Jesus Christ - Our Lord revealed to him at first, his resurrection,
ascension, and the calling of the gentiles, and his own apostleship; and
told him then, there were other things for which he would appear to
him.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p12">13. I Persecuted the church of God - That is, the believers
in Christ.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p13">14. Being zealous of the unwritten traditions - Over and
above those written in the law.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p14">15. But when it pleased God - He ascribes nothing to his
own merits, endeavours, or sincerity. Who separated me from my mother's
womb - Set me apart for an apostle, as he did Jeremiah for a prophet. <scripRef passage="Jer. i. 5" id="i.x.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Jer|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.1.5">Jer. i, 5</scripRef>. Such an unconditional predestination as this may consist,
both with God's justice and mercy. And called me by his grace - By his
free and almighty love, to be both a Christian and an apostle.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p15">16. To reveal his Son in me - By the powerful operation of
his Spirit, chap. iv, 6; as well as to me, by the heavenly vision. That
I might preach him to others - Which I should have been ill qualified to
do, had I not first known him myself. I did not confer with flesh and
blood - Being fully satisfied of the divine will, and determined to
obey, I took no counsel with any man, neither with my own reason or
inclinations, which might have raised numberless objections.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p16">17. Neither did I go up to Jerusalem - The residence of the
apostles. But I immediately went again into Arabia, and returned again
to Damascus - He presupposes the journey to Damascus, in which he was
converted, as being known to them all.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p17">18. Then after three years - Wherein I had given full proof
of my apostleship. I went to visit Peter - To converse with him.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p18">19. But other of the apostles I saw none, save James the
brother (that is, the kinsman) of the Lord - Therefore when Barnabas is
said to have "brought him into the apostles," <scripRef passage="Acts ix. 27" id="i.x.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Acts|9|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.9.27">Acts ix, 27</scripRef>, only St. Peter and St James are meant.</p>

<p id="i.x.ii-p19">24. In me - That is, on my account.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="18.15%" prev="i.x.ii" next="i.x.iv" id="i.x.iii">
<h3 id="i.x.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gal. II" id="i.x.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Gal|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.2" /> 

<p id="i.x.iii-p1">1. Then fourteen years after - My first journey thither. I
went up again to Jerusalem - This seems to be the journey mentioned <scripRef passage="Acts xv. 2" id="i.x.iii-p1.1" parsed="|Acts|15|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.15.2">Acts xv, 2</scripRef>; several passages here referring to that great council,
wherein all the apostles showed that they were of the same judgment with
him.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p2">2. I went up - Not by any command from them, but by an
express Revelation from God. And laid before them - The chief of the
church in Jerusalem. The gospel which I preach among the gentiles - <scripRef passage="Acts xv. 4" id="i.x.iii-p2.1" parsed="|Acts|15|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.15.4">Acts xv, 4</scripRef>, touching justification by faith alone; not that they might
confirm me therein, but that I might remove prejudice from them. Yet not
publicly at first, but severally to those of eminence - Speaking to them
one by one. Lest I should run, or should have run, in vain - Lest I
should lose the fruit either of my present or past labours. For they
might have greatly hindered this, had they not been fully satisfied both
of his mission and doctrine. The word run beautifully expresses the
swift progress of the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p3">3. But neither was Titus who was with me - When I conversed
with them. Compelled to be circumcised - A clear proof that none of the
apostles insisted on the circumcising gentile believers. The sense is,
And it is true, some of those false brethren would fain have compelled
Titus to be circumcised; but I utterly refused it.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p4">4. Because of false brethren -- who seem to have urged it.
Introduced unawares - Into some of those private conferences at
Jerusalem. Who had slipped in to spy out our liberty - From the
ceremonial law. That they might, if possible, bring us into that bondage
again.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p5">5. To whom we did not yield by submission - Although in
love he would have yielded to any. With such wonderful prudence did the
apostle use his Christian liberty! circumcising Timothy, <scripRef passage="Acts xvi. 3" id="i.x.iii-p5.1" parsed="|Acts|16|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.16.3">Acts xvi, 3</scripRef>, because of weak brethren, but not Titus, because of false
brethren. That the truth of the gospel - That is, the true genuine
gospel. Might continue with you - With you gentiles. So we defend, for
your sakes, the privilege which you would give up.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p6">6. And they who undoubtedly were something - Above all
others. What they were - How eminent soever. It is no difference to me -
So that I should alter either my doctrine or my practice. God accepteth
no man's person - For any eminence in gifts or outward prerogatives. In
that conference added nothing to me - Neither as to doctrine nor
mission.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p7">7. But when they saw - By the effects which I laid before
them, ver. 8; <scripRef passage="Acts xv. 12" id="i.x.iii-p7.1" parsed="|Acts|15|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.15.12">Acts xv, 12</scripRef>. That I was intrusted with the gospel of the uncircumcision
- That is, with the charge of preaching it to the uncircumcised
heathens.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p8">8. For he that wrought effectually in Peter for the
apostleship of the circumcision - To qualify him for, and support him
in, the discharge of that office to the Jews. Wrought likewise
effectually in and by me - For and in the discharge of my office toward
the gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p9">9. And when James - Probably named first because he was
bishop of the church in Jerusalem. And Cephas - Speaking of him at
Jerusalem he calls him by his Hebrew name. And John - Hence it appears
that he also was at the council, though he is not particularly named in
the Acts. Who undoubtedly were pillars - The principal supporters and
defenders of the gospel. Knew - After they had heard the account I gave
them. The grace - Of apostleship. Which was given me, they - In the name
of all. Gave to me and Barnabas - My fellow-labourer. The right hands of
fellowship - They gave us their hands in token of receiving us as their
fellow- labourers, mutually agreeing that we - I and those in union with
me. Should go to the gentiles - Chiefly. And they - With those that were
in union with them, chiefly to the circumcision - The Jews.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p10">10. Of the poor - The poor Christians in Judea, who had
lost all they had for Christ's sake.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p11">11. But - The argument here comes to the height. Paul
reproves Peter himself. So far was he from receiving his doctrine from
man, or from being inferior to the chief of the apostles. When Peter -
Afterwards, Came to Antioch - Then the chief of all the Gentile
churches. I withstood him to the face, because he was to be blamed - For
fear of man, ver. 12; for dissimulation, ver. 13; and for not walking
uprightly. ver. 14.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p12">13. And the other believing Jews - Who were at Antioch.
Dissembled with him, so that even Barnabas was carried away with their
dissimulation - Was born away, as with a torrent, into the same ill
practice.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p13">14. I said to Cephas before them all - See Paul single
against Peter and all the Jews! If thou being a Jew, yet livest, in thy
ordinary conversation, after the manner of the gentiles - Not observing
the ceremonial law, which thou knowest to be now abolished. Why
compellest thou the gentiles - By withdrawing thyself and all the
ministers from them; either to judaize, to keep the ceremonial law, or
to be excluded from church communion?</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p14">15. We - St. Paul, to spare St. Peter, drops the first
person singular, and speaks in the plural number. ver. 18, he speaks in
the first person singular again by a figure; and without a figure, ver.
19, &amp;c. Who are Jews by nature - By birth, not proselytes only. And
not sinners of the gentiles - That is, not sinful Gentiles; not such
gross, enormous, abandoned sinners, as the heathens generally were.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p15">16. Knowing that a man is not justified by the works of the
law - Not even of the moral, much less the ceremonial, law. But by the
faith of Jesus Christ - That is, by faith in him. The name Jesus was
first known by the gentiles; the name Christ by the Jews. And they are
not always placed promiscuously; but generally in a more solemn way of
speaking, the Apostle says, Christ Jesus; in a more familiar, Jesus
Christ. Even we - And how much more must the Gentiles, who have still
less pretense to depend on their own works! Have believed - Knowing
there is no other way. Because - Considering the demands of the law, and
the fate of human nature, it is evident, that by the works of the law -
By such an obedience as it requires. Shall no flesh living - No human
creature, Jew or Gentile, be justified. Hitherto St. Paul had been
considering that single question, "Are Christians obliged to observe the
ceremonial law? But he here insensibly goes farther, and, by citing this
scripture, shows that what he spoke directly of the ceremonial, included
also the moral, law. For David undoubtedly did so, when he said, <scripRef passage="Psalm cxliii. 2" id="i.x.iii-p15.1" parsed="|Ps|143|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.143.2">Psalm cxliii, 2</scripRef>, the place here referred to, "In thy sight shall no man
living be justified;" which the Apostle likewise explains, <scripRef passage="Rom. iii. 19, 20" id="i.x.iii-p15.2" parsed="|Rom|3|19|3|20" osisRef="Bible:Rom.3.19-Rom.3.20">Rom. iii, 19, 20</scripRef>, in such a manner as can agree to none but the moral
law.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p16">17. But if while we seek to be justified by Christ, we
ourselves are still found sinners - If we continue in sin, will it
therefore follow, that Christ is the minister or countenancer of
sin?</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p17">18. By no means. For if I build again - By my sinful
practice. The things which I destroyed - By my preaching, I only make
myself - Or show myself, not Christ, to be a transgressor; the whole
blame lies on me, not him or his gospel. As if he had said, The
objection were just, if the gospel promised justification to men
continuing in sin. But it does not. Therefore if any who profess the
gospel do not live according to it, they are sinners, it is certain, but
not justified, and so the gospel is clear.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p18">19. For I through the law - Applied by the Spirit to my
heart, and deeply convincing me of my utter sinfulness and helplessness.
Am dead to the law - To all hope of justification from it. That I may
live to God - Not continue in sin. For this very end am I, in this
sense, freed from the law, that I may be freed from sin.</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p19">20. The Apostle goes on to describe how he is freed from
sin; how far he is from continuing therein. I am crucified with Christ -
Made conformable to his death; "the body of sin is destroyed." <scripRef passage="Rom. vi. 6" id="i.x.iii-p19.1" parsed="|Rom|6|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.6.6">Rom. vi, 6</scripRef>. And I - As to my corrupt nature. Live no longer - Being
dead to sin. But Christ liveth in me - Is a fountain of life in my
inmost soul, from which all my tempers, words, and actions flow. And the
life that I now live in the flesh - Even in this mortal body, I live by
faith in the Son of God - I derive every moment from that supernatural
principle; from a divine evidence and conviction, that "he loved me, and
delivered up himself for me."</p>

<p id="i.x.iii-p20">21. Meantime I do not make void - In seeking to be
justified by my own works. The grace of God - The free love of God in
Christ Jesus. But they do, who seek justification by the law. For if
righteousness is by the law - If men might be justified by their
obedience to the law, moral or ceremonial. Then Christ died in vain -
Without any necessity for it, since men might have been saved without
his death; might by their own obedience have been both discharged from
condemnation, and entitled to eternal life.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="18.31%" prev="i.x.iii" next="i.x.v" id="i.x.iv">
<h3 id="i.x.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gal. III" id="i.x.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Gal|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.3" /> 

<p id="i.x.iv-p1">1. O thoughtless Galatians - He breaks in upon them with a
beautiful abruptness. Who hath bewitched you - Thus to contradict both
your own reason and experience. Before whose eyes Jesus Christ hath been
as evidently set forth - By our preaching, as if he had been crucified
among you.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p2">2. This only would I learn of you - That is, this one
argument might convince you. Did ye receive the witness and the fruit of
the Spirit by performing the works of the law, or by hearing of and
receiving faith?</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p3">3. Are ye so thoughtless - As not to consider what you have
yourselves experienced? Having begun in the Spirit - Having set out
under the light and power of the Spirit by faith, do ye now, when ye
ought to be more spiritual, and more acquainted with the power of faith,
expect to be made perfect by the flesh? Do you think to complete either
your justification or sanctification, by giving up that faith, and
depending on the law, which is a gross and carnal thing when opposed to
the gospel?</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p4">4. Have ye suffered - Both from the zealous Jews and from
the heathens. So many things - For adhering to the gospel. In vain - So
as to lose all the blessings which ye might have obtained, by enduring
to the end. If it be yet in vain - As if he had said, I hope better
things, even that ye will endure to the end.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p5">5. And, at the present time, Doth he that ministereth the
gift of the Spirit to you, and worketh miracles among you, do it by the
works of the law - That is, in confirmation of his preaching
justification by works, or of his preaching justification by faith?</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p6">6. Doubtless in confirmation of that grand doctrine, that
we are justified by faith, even as Abraham was. The Apostle, both in
this and in the epistle to the Romans, makes great use of the instance
of Abraham: the rather, because from Abraham the Jews drew their great
argument, as they do this day, both for their own continuance in
Judaism, and for denying the gentiles to be the church of God. <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 6" id="i.x.iv-p6.1" parsed="|Gen|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.6">Gen. xv, 6</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p7">7. Know then that they who are partakers of his faith,
these, and these only, are the sons of Abraham, and therefore heirs of
the promises made to him.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p8">8. And the scripture - That is, the Holy Spirit, who gave
the scripture. Foreseeing that God would justify the gentiles also by
faith, declared before - So great is the excellency and fulness of the
scripture, that all the things which can ever be controverted are
therein both foreseen and determined. In or through thee - As the father
of the Messiah, shall all the nations be blessed. <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 3" id="i.x.iv-p8.1" parsed="|Gen|12|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.3">Gen. xii, 3</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p9">9. So then all they, and they only, who are of faith - Who
truly believe. Are blessed with faithful Abraham - Receive the blessing
as he did, namely, by faith.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p10">10. They only receive it. For as many as are of the works
of the law - As God deals with on that footing, only on the terms the
law proposes, are under a curse; for it is written, Cursed is every one
who continueth not in all the things which are written in the law. Who
continueth not in all the things - So it requires what no man can
perform, namely, perfect, uninterrupted, and perpetual obedience. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxvii. 26" id="i.x.iv-p10.1" parsed="|Deut|27|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.27.26">Deut. xxvii, 26</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p11">11. But that none is justified by his obedience to the law
in the sight of God - Whatever may be done in the sight of man, is
farther evident from the words of Habakkuk, The just shall live by faith
- That is, the man who is accounted just or righteous before God, shall
continue in a state of acceptance, life, and salvation, by faith. This
is the way God hath chosen. <scripRef passage="Hab. ii. 4" id="i.x.iv-p11.1" parsed="|Hab|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hab.2.4">Hab. ii,
4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p12">12. And the law is not of faith - But quite opposite to it:
it does not say, Believe; but, Do. <scripRef passage="Lev. xviii. 5" id="i.x.iv-p12.1" parsed="|Lev|18|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.18.5">Lev. xviii, 5</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p13">13. Christ - Christ alone. The abruptness of the sentence
shows an holy indignation at those who reject so great a blessing. Hath
redeemed us - Whether Jews or gentiles, at an high price. From the curse
of the law - The curse of God, which the law denounces against all
transgressors of it. Being made a curse for us - Taking the curse upon
himself, that we might be delivered from it, willingly submitting to
that death which the law pronounces peculiarly accursed. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxi. 23" id="i.x.iv-p13.1" parsed="|Deut|21|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.21.23">Deut. xxi, 23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p14">14. That the blessing of Abraham - The blessing promised to
him. Might come on the gentiles - Also. That we - Who believe, whether
Jews or gentiles. Might receive the promise of the Spirit - Which
includes all the other promises. Through faith - Not by works; for faith
looks wholly to the promise.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p15">15. I speak after the manner of men - I illustrate this by
a familiar instance, taken from the practice of men. Though it be but a
man's covenant, yet, if it be once legally confirmed, none - No, not the
covenanter himself, unless something unforeseen occur, which cannot be
the case with God. Disannulleth, or addeth thereto - Any new
conditions.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p16">16. Now the promises were made to Abraham and his seed -
Several promises were made to Abraham; but the chief of all, and which
was several times repeated, was that of the blessing through Christ. He
- That is, God. Saith not, And to seeds, as of many - As if the promise
were made to several kinds of seed. But as of one - That is, one kind of
seed, one posterity, one kind of sons. And to all these the blessing
belonged by promise. Which is Christ - including all that believe in
him. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxii. 18" id="i.x.iv-p16.1" parsed="|Gen|22|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.22.18">Gen. xxii, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p17">17. And this I say - What I mean is this. The covenant
which was before confirmed of God - By the promise itself, by the
repetition of it, and by a solemn oath, concerning the blessing all
nations. Through Christ, the law which was four hundred and thirty years
after - Counting from the time when the promise was first made to
Abraham, <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 2, 3" id="i.x.iv-p17.1" parsed="|Gen|12|2|12|3" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.2-Gen.12.3">Gen. xii, 2, 3</scripRef>. Doth not disannul, so as to make the promise of no effect -
With regard to all nations, if only the Jewish were to receive it; yea,
with regard to them also, if it was by works, so as to supersede it, and
introduce another way of obtaining the blessing.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p18">18. And again - This is a new argument. The former was
drawn from the time, this from the nature, of the transaction. If the
eternal inheritance be obtained by keeping the law, it is no more by
virtue of the free promise - These being just opposite to each other.
But it is by promise. Therefore it is not by the law.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p19">19. It - The ceremonial law. Was added - To the promise.
Because of transgressions - Probably, the yoke of the ceremonial law was
inflicted as a punishment for the national sin of idolatry, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxii. 1" id="i.x.iv-p19.1" parsed="|Exod|32|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.32.1">Exod. xxxii, 1</scripRef>, at least the more grievous parts of it; and the whole of it
was a prophetic type of Christ. The moral law was added to the promise
to discover and restrain transgressions, to convince men of their guilt,
and need of the promise, and give some check to sin. And this law
passeth not away; but the ceremonial law was only introduced till
Christ, the seed to or through whom the promise was made, should come.
And it was ordained by angels in the hand of a mediator - It was not
given to Israel, like the promise to Abraham, immediately from God
himself; but was conveyed by the ministry of angels to Moses, and
delivered into his hand as a mediator between God and them, to remind
them of the great Mediator.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p20">20. Now the mediator is not a mediator of one - There must
be two parties, or there can be no mediator between them; but God who
made the free promise to Abraham is only one of the parties. The other,
Abraham, was not present at the time of Moses. Therefore in the promise
Moses had nothing to do. The law, wherein he was concerned, was a
transaction of quite another nature.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p21">21. Will it follow from hence that the law is against,
opposite to, the promises of God? By no means. They are well consistent.
But yet the law cannot give life, as the promise doth. If there had been
a law which could have given life - Which could have entitled a sinner
to life, God would have spared his own Son, and righteousness, or
justification. with all the blessings consequent upon it, would have
been by that law.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p22">22. But, on the contrary, the scripture wherein that law is
written hath concluded all under sin - Hath shut them up together, (so
the word properly signifies,) as in a prison, under sentence of death,
to the end that all being cut off from expecting justification by the
law, the promise might be freely given to them that believe.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p23">23. But before faith - That is, the gospel dispensation.
Came, we were kept - As in close custody. Under the law - The Mosaic
dispensation. Shut up unto the faith which was to be revealed - Reserved
and prepared for the gospel dispensation.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p24">24. Wherefore the law was our schoolmaster unto Christ - It
was designed to train us up for Christ. And this it did both by its
commands, which showed the need we had of his atonement; and its
ceremonies, which all pointed us to him.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p25">25. But faith - That is, the gospel dispensation. Being
come, we are no longer under that schoolmaster - The Mosaic
dispensation.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p26">26. For ye - Christians. Are all adult sons of God - And so
need a schoolmaster no longer.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p27">27. For as many of you as have testified your faith by
being baptized in the name of Christ, have put on Christ - Have received
him as your righteousness, and are therefore sons of God through
him.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p28">28. There is neither Jew nor Greek - That is, there is no
difference between them; they are equally accepted through faith. There
is neither male nor female - Circumcision being laid aside, which was
peculiar to males, and was designed to put a difference, during that
dispensation, between Jews and gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.x.iv-p29">29. If ye are Christ's - That is, believers in him.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="18.47%" prev="i.x.iv" next="i.x.vi" id="i.x.v">
<h3 id="i.x.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gal. IV" id="i.x.v-p0.2" parsed="|Gal|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.4" /> 

<p id="i.x.v-p1">1. Now - To illustrate by a plain similitude the
preeminence of the Christian, over the legal, dispensation. The heir, as
long as he is a child - As he is under age. Differeth nothing from a
servant - Not being at liberty either to use or enjoy his estate. Though
he be Lord - Proprietor of it all.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p2">2. But is under tutors - As to his person. And stewards -
As to his substance.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p3">3. So we - The church of God. When we were children - In
our minority, under the legal dispensation. Were in bondage - In a kind
of servile state. Under the elements of the world - Under the typical
observances of the law, which were like the first elements of grammar,
the A B C of children; and were of so gross a nature, as hardly to carry
our thoughts beyond this world.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p4">4. But when the fulness of the time - Appointed by the
Father, ver. 2. Was come, God sent forth - From his own bosom. His Son,
miraculously made of the substance of a woman - A virgin, without the
concurrence of a man. Made under the law - Both under the precept, and
under the curse, of it.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p5">5. To redeem those under the law - From the curse of it,
and from that low, servile state. That we - Jews who believe. Might
receive the adoption - All the privileges of adult sons.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p6">6. And because ye - Gentiles who believe, are also thus
made his adult sons, God hath sent forth the Spirit of his Son into your
hearts likewise, crying, Abba, Father - Enabling you to call upon God
both with the confidence, and the tempers, of dutiful children. The
Hebrew and Greek word are joined together, to express the joint cry of
the Jews and gentiles.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p7">7. Wherefore thou - Who believest in Christ. Art no more a
servant - Like those who are under the law. But a son - Of mature age.
And if a son, then an heir of all the promises, and of the all-
sufficient God himself.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p8">8. Indeed then when ye knew not God, ye served them that by
nature - That is, in reality. Are no gods - And so were under a far
worse bondage than even that of the Jews. For they did serve the true
God, though in a low, slavish manner.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p9">9. But now being known of God - As his beloved children.
How turn ye back to the weak and poor elements - Weak, utterly unable to
purge your conscience from guilt, or to give that filial confidence in
God. Poor - incapable of enriching the soul with such holiness and
happiness as ye are heirs to. Ye desire to be again in bondage - Though
of another kind; now to these elements, as before to those idols.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p10">10. Ye observe days - Jewish sabbaths. And months - New
moons. And times - As that of the passover, pentecost, and the feast of
tabernacles. And years - Annual solemnities. it does not mean sabbatic
years. These were not to be observed out of the land of Canaan.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p11">11. The apostle here, dropping the argument, applies to the
affections, ver. 11-20, and humbles himself to the Galatians, with an
inexpressible tenderness.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p12">12. Brethren, I beseech you, be as I am - Meet me in mutual
love. For I am as ye were - I still love you as affectionately as ye
once loved me. Why should I not? Ye have not injured me at all - I have
received no personal injury from you.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p13">13. I preached to you, notwithstanding infirmity of the
flesh - That is, notwithstanding bodily weakness, and under great
disadvantage from the despicableness of my outward appearance.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p14">14. And ye did not slight my temptation - That is, ye did
not slight or disdain me for my temptation, my "thorn in the flesh."</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p15">15. What was then the blessedness ye spake of - On which ye
so congratulated one another.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p16">17. They - The judaizing teachers who are come among you.
Zealously affect you - Express an extraordinary regard for you. But not
well - Their zeal is not according to knowledge; neither have they a
single eye to your spiritual advantage. Yea, they would exclude you -
From me and from the blessings of the gospel. That ye might affect -
Love and esteem them.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p17">18. In a good thing - In what is really worthy our zeal.
True zeal is only fervent love.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p18">19. My little children - He speaks as a parent, both with
authority, and the most tender sympathy, toward weak and sickly
children. Of whom I travail in birth again - As I did before, ver. 13,
in vehement pain, sorrow, desire, prayer. Till Christ be formed in you -
Till there be in you all the mind that was in him.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p19">20. I could wish to be present with you now - Particularly
in this exigence. And to change - Variously to attemper. My voice - He
writes with much softness; but he would speak with more. The voice may
more easily be varied according to the occasion than a letter can. For I
stand in doubt of you - So that I am at a loss how to speak at this
distance.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p20">21. Do ye not hear the law - Regard what it says.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p21">22. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxi. 2, 9" id="i.x.v-p21.1" parsed="|Gen|21|2|0|0;|Gen|21|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.21.2 Bible:Gen.21.9">Gen. xxi, 2,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p22">23. Was born after the flesh - In a natural way. By promise
- Through that supernatural strength which was given Abraham in
consequence of the promise.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p23">24. Which things are an allegory - An allegory is a
figurative speech, wherein one thing is expressed, and another intended.
For those two sons are types of the two covenants. One covenant is that
given from Mount Sinai, which beareth children to bondage - That is, all
who are under this, the Jewish covenant, are in bondage. Which covenant
is typified by Agar.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p24">25. For this is Mount Sinai in Arabia - That is, the type
of Mount Sinai. And answereth to - Resembles Jerusalem that now is, and
is in bondage - Like Agar, both to the law and to the Romans.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p25">26. But the other covenant is derived from Jerusalem that
is above, which is free - Like Sarah from all inward and outward
bondage, and is the mother of us all - That is, all who believe in
Christ, are free citizens of the New Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p26">27. For it is written - Those words in the primary sense
promise a flourishing state to Judea, after its desolation by the
Chaldeans. Rejoice. thou barren, that bearest not - Ye heathen nations,
who, like a barren woman, were destitute, for many ages, of a seed to
serve the Lord. Break forth and cry aloud for joy, thou that, in former
time, travailedst not: for the desolate hath many more children than she
that hath an husband - For ye that were so long utterly desolate shall
at length bear more children than the Jewish church, which was of old
espoused to God. <scripRef passage="Isaiah liv. 1" id="i.x.v-p26.1" parsed="|Isa|54|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.54.1">Isaiah liv,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p27">28. Now we - Who believe, whether Jews or Gentiles. Are
children of the promise - Not born in a natural way, but by the
supernatural power of God. And as such we are heirs of the promise made
to believing Abraham.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p28">29. But as then, he that was born after the flesh
persecuted him that was born after the Spirit, so it is now also - And
so it will be in all ages and nations to the end of the world.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p29">30. But what saith the scripture - Showing the consequence
of this. Cast out the bondwoman and her son - Who mocked Isaac. In like
manner will God cast out all who seek to be justified by the law;
especially if they persecute them who are his children by faith. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxi. 10" id="i.x.v-p29.1" parsed="|Gen|21|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.21.10">Gen. xxi, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.x.v-p30">31. So then - To sum up all. We - Who believe. Are not
children of the bondwoman - Have nothing to do with the servile Mosaic
dispensation. But of the free - Being free from the curse and the bond
of that law, and from the power of sin and Satan.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="18.60%" prev="i.x.v" next="i.x.vii" id="i.x.vi">
<h3 id="i.x.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gal. V" id="i.x.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Gal|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.5" /> 

<p id="i.x.vi-p1">1. Stand fast therefore in the liberty - From the
ceremonial law. Wherewith Christ hath made us - And all believers, free;
and be not entangled again with the yoke of legal bondage.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p2">2. If ye be circumcised - And seek to be justified thereby.
Christ - The Christian institution. Will profit you nothing - For you
hereby disclaim Christ, and all the blessings which are through faith in
him.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p3">3. I testify to every man - Every gentile. That is
circumcised - He thereby makes himself a debtor - Obliges.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p4">4. Therefore Christ is become of no effect to you - Who
seek to be justified by the law. Ye are fallen from grace - Ye renounce
the new covenant. Ye disclaim the benefit of this gracious
dispensation.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p5">5. For we - Who believe in Christ, Who are under the gospel
dispensation. Through the Spirit - Without any of those carnal
ordinances. Wait for - in sure confidence of attaining. The hope of
righteousness - The righteousness we hope for, and full reward of it.
This righteousness we receive of God through faith; and by faith we
shall obtain the reward.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p6">6. For in Christ Jesus - According to the institution which
he hath established, according to the tenor of the Christian covenant.
Neither circumcision - With the most punctual observance of the law. Nor
uncircumcision - With the most exact heathen morality. Availeth anything
- Toward present justification or eternal salvation. But faith - Alone;
even that faith which worketh by love - All inward and outward
holiness.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p7">7. Ye did run well - In the race of faith. Who hath
hindered you in your course, that ye should not still obey the
truth?</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p8">8. This your present persuasion cometh not from God, who
called you - to his kingdom and glory.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p9">9. A little leaven leaveneth the whole lump - One troubler,
ver. 10, troubles all.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p10">10. Yet I have confidence that - After ye have read this.
Ye will be no otherwise minded - Than I am, and ye were. But he that
troubleth you - It seems to have been one person chiefly who endeavoured
to seduce them. Shall bear his judgment - A heavy burden, already
hanging over his head.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p11">11. But if I still preach circumcision - As that troubler
seems to have affirmed, probably taking occasion from his having
circumcised Timothy. Why do I still suffer persecution? then is the
offense of the cross ceased - The grand reason why the Jews were so
offended at his preaching Christ crucified, and so bitterly persecuted
him for it, was, that it implied the abolition of the law. Yet St. Paul
did not condemn the conforming, out of condescension to the weakness of
any one, even to the ceremonial law; but he did absolutely condemn those
who taught it as necessary to justification.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p12">12. I would they were even cut off - From your communion;
cast out of your church, that thus trouble you.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p13">13. Ye have been called to liberty - From sin and misery,
as well as from the ceremonial law. Only use not liberty for an occasion
to the flesh - Take not occasion from hence to gratify corrupt nature.
But by love serve one another - And hereby show that Christ has made you
free.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p14">14. For all the law is fulfilled in this, Thou shalt love
thy neighbour as thyself - inasmuch as none can do this without loving
God, <scripRef passage="1 John iv. 12" id="i.x.vi-p14.1" parsed="|1John|4|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.4.12">1 John iv, 12</scripRef>; and the love of God and man includes all perfection. <scripRef passage="Lev. xix. 18" id="i.x.vi-p14.2" parsed="|Lev|19|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.18">Lev. xix, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p15">15. But if - On the contrary, in consequence of the
divisions which those troublers have occasioned among you, ye bite one
another by evil speaking. And devour one another - By railing and
clamour. Take heed ye be not consumed one of another - By bitterness,
strife, and contention, our health and strength, both of body and soul,
are consumed, as well as our substance and reputation.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p16">16. I say then - He now explains what he proposed, ver. 13.
Walk by the Spirit - Follow his guidance in all things. And fulfil not -
In anything. The desire of the flesh - Of corrupt nature.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p17">17. For the flesh desireth against the Spirit - Nature
desires what is quite contrary to the Spirit of God. But the Spirit
against the flesh- - But the Holy Spirit on his part opposes your evil
nature. These are contrary to each other - The flesh and the Spirit;
there can be no agreement between them. That ye may not do the things
which ye would- - That, being thus strengthened by the Spirit, ye may
not fulfil the desire of the flesh, as otherwise ye would do.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p18">18. But if ye are led by the Spirit - Of liberty and love,
into all holiness. Ye are not under the law - Not under the curse or
bondage of it; not under the guilt or the power of sin.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p19">19. Now the works of the flesh - By which that inward
principle is discovered. Are manifest - Plain and undeniable. Works are
mentioned in the plural because they are distinct from, and often
inconsistent with, each other. But "the fruit of the Spirit" is
mentioned in the singular, ver. 22, as being all consistent and
connected together. Which are these - He enumerates those "works of the
flesh" to which the Galatians were most inclined; and those parts of
"the fruit of the Spirit" of which they stood in the greatest need.
Lasciviousness - The Greek word means anything inward or outward that is
contrary to chastity, and yet short of actual uncleanness.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p20">20. Idolatry, witchcraft - That this means witchcraft,
strictly speaking, (not poisoning,) appears from its being joined with
the worship of devil-gods, and not with murder. This is frequently and
solemnly forbidden in the Old Testament. To deny therefore that there
is, or ever was, any such thing, is, by plain consequence, to deny the
authority both of the Old and New Testament. Divisions - In domestic or
civil matters. Heresies are divisions in religious communities.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p21">21. Revellings - Luxurious entertainments. Some of the
works here mentioned are wrought principally, if not entirely, in the
mind; and yet they are called "works of the flesh." Hence it is clear,
the apostle does not by "the flesh" mean the body, or sensual appetites
and inclinations only, but the corruption of human nature, as it spreads
through all the powers of the soul, as well as all the members of the
body. Of which I tell you before - Before the event, I forewarn you.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p22">22. Love - The root of all the rest. Gentleness - Toward
all men; ignorant and wicked men in particular. Goodness - The Greek
word means all that is benign, soft, winning, tender, either in temper
or behaviour.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p23">23. Meekness - Holding all the affections and passions in
even balance.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p24">24. And they that are Christ's - True believers in him.
Have thus crucified the flesh - Nailed it, as it were, to a cross whence
it has no power to break loose, but is continually weaker and weaker.
With its affections and desires - All its evil passions, appetites, and
inclinations.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p25">25. If we live by the Spirit - If we are indeed raised from
the dead, and are alive to God, by the operation of his Spirit. Let us
walk by the Spirit - Let us follow his guidance, in all our tempers,
thoughts, words, and actions.</p>

<p id="i.x.vi-p26">26. Be not desirous of vain glory - Of the praise or esteem
of men. They who do not carefully and closely follow the Spirit, easily
slide into this: the natural effects of which are, provoking to envy
them that are beneath us, and envying them that are above us.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="18.73%" prev="i.x.vi" next="i.xi" id="i.x.vii">
<h3 id="i.x.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gal. VI" id="i.x.vii-p0.2" parsed="|Gal|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.6" /> 

<p id="i.x.vii-p1">1. Brethren, if a man be overtaken in any fault - By
surprise, ignorance, or stress of temptation. Ye who are spiritual - Who
continue to live and walk by the Spirit. Restore such an one - By
reproof, instruction, or exhortation. Everyone who can, ought to help
herein; only in the spirit of meekness - This is essential to a
spiritual man; and in this lies the whole force of the cure. Considering
thyself - The plural is beautifully changed into the singular. Let each
take heed to himself. Lest thou also be tempted - Temptation easily and
swiftly passes from one to another; especially if a man endeavours to
cure another without preserving his own meekness.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p2">2. Bear ye one another's burdens - Sympathize with, and
assist, each other, in all your weaknesses, grievances, trials. And so
fulfil the law of Christ - The law of Christ (an uncommon expression) is
the law of love: this our Lord peculiarly recommends; this he makes the
distinguishing mark of his disciples.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p3">3. If any one think himself to be something - Above his
brethren, or by any strength of his own. When he is nothing, he
deceiveth himself - He alone will bear their burdens, who knows himself
to be nothing.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p4">4. But let every man try his own work - Narrowly examine
all he is, and all he doeth. And then he shall have rejoicing in himself
- He will find in himself matter of rejoicing, if his works are right
before God. And not in another - Not in glorying over others.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p5">5. For every one shall bear his own burden - ln that day
shall give an account of himself to God.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p6">6. Let him that is taught impart to him that teacheth all
such temporal good things as he stands in need of.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p7">7. God is not mocked - Although they attempt to mock him,
who think to reap otherwise than they sow.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p8">8. For he that now soweth to the flesh - That follows the
desires of corrupt nature. Shall hereafter of the flesh - Out of this
very seed. Reap corruption - Death everlasting. But he that soweth to
the Spirit - That follows his guidance in all his tempers and
conversation. Shall of the Spirit - By the free grace and power of God,
reap life everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p9">9. But let us not be weary in well doing - Let us persevere
in sowing to the Spirit. For in due season - When the harvest is come,
we shall reap, if we faint not.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p10">10. Therefore as we have opportunity - At whatever time or
place, and in whatever manner we can. The opportunity in general is our
lifetime; but there are also many particular opportunities. Satan is
quickened in doing hurt, by the shortness of the time, <scripRef passage="Rev. xii. 12" id="i.x.vii-p10.1" parsed="|Rev|12|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.12.12">Rev. xii, 12</scripRef>. By the same consideration let us be quickened in doing
good. Let us do good - In every possible kind, and in every possible
degree. Unto all men - neighbours or strangers, good or evil, friends or
enemies. But especially to them who are of the household of faith. For
all believers are but one family.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p11">11. Ye see how large a letter - St. Paul had not yet wrote
a larger to any church. I have written with my own hand - He generally
wrote by an amanuensis.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p12">12. As many as desire to make a fair appearance in the
flesh - To preserve a fair character. These constrain you - Both by
their example and importunity. To be circumcised - Not so much from a
principle of conscience, as lest they should suffer persecution - From
the unbelieving Jews. For the cross of Christ - For maintaining that
faith in a crucified saviour is alone sufficient for justification.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p13">13. For neither they themselves keep the whole law - So far
are they from a real zeal for it. But yet they desire to have you
circumcised, that they may glory in your flesh - That they may boast of
you as their proselytes, and make a merit of this with the other
Jews.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p14">14. But God forbid that I should glory - Should boast of
anything I have, am, or do; or rely on anything for my acceptance with
God, but what Christ hath done and suffered for me. By means of which
the world is crucified to me - All the things and persons in it are to
me as nothing. And I unto the world - I am dead to all worldly pursuits,
cares, desires, and enjoyments.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p15">15. For neither circumcision is anything, nor
uncircumcision - Neither of these is of any account. But a new creation
- Whereby all things in us become new.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p16">16. And as many as walk according to this rule -</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.vii-p17">1. Glorying only in the cross of Christ.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.vii-p18">2. Being crucified to the world. And,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.x.vii-p19">3. Created anew. Peace and mercy be upon
them, and upon the Israel, that is, the Church, of God - Which consists
of all those, and those only, of every nation and kindred, who walk by
this rule.</p>

<p id="i.x.vii-p20">17. From henceforth let none trouble me - By quarrels and
disputes. For I bear - And afflictions should not be added to the
afflicted. In my body the marks of the Lord Jesus - The scars, marks,
and brands of my sufferings for Him.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE EPHESIANS" progress="18.81%" prev="i.x.vii" next="i.xi.i" id="i.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Eph" id="i.xi-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xi-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE EPHESIANS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Ephesians" progress="18.81%" prev="i.xi" next="i.xi.ii" id="i.xi.i">

<p id="i.xi.i-p1">EPHESUS was the chief city of that part of Asia, which was
a Roman province. Here St. Paul preached for three years, <scripRef passage="Acts xx. 31" id="i.xi.i-p1.1" parsed="|Acts|20|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.20.31">Acts xx, 31</scripRef>; and from hence the gospel was spread throughout the whole
province, <scripRef passage="Acts xix. 10" id="i.xi.i-p1.2" parsed="|Acts|19|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.19.10">Acts
xix, 10</scripRef>. At his taking leave of the church there, he forewarned them
both of great persecutions from without, and of divers heresies and
schisms which would arise among themselves. And accordingly he writes
this epistle, nearly resembling that to the Colossians, written about
the same time, to establish them in the doctrine he had delivered, to
arm them against false teachers, and to build them up in love and
holiness, both of heart and conversation. He begins this, as most of his
epistles, with thanksgiving to God for their embracing and adhering to
the gospel. He shows the inestimable blessings and advantages they
received thereby, as far above all the Jewish privileges, as all the
wisdom and philosophy of the heathens. He proves that our Lord is the
Head of the whole church; of angels and spirits, the church triumphant,
and of Jews and gentiles, now equally members of the church militant. In
the three last chapters he exhorts them to various duties, civil and
religious, personal and relative, suitable to their Christian character,
privileges, assistances, and obligations. In this epistle we may
observe,</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xi.i-p2">I. The inscription, Chap. i. 1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xi.i-p3">II. The doctrine pathetically explained,
which contains,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xi.i-p4">1. Praise to God for the whole gospel
blessing, 3-14 With thanksgiving and prayer for the saints, 15- ii.
10</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xi.i-p5">2. A more particular admonition concerning
their once miserable, but now happy, condition, 11-12 A prayer for their
establishment, iii. 1-19 A doxology, 20, 21</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xi.i-p6">III. The exhortation,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xi.i-p7">1. General: to walk worthy of their calling,
agreeably to,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.i-p8">1.The unity of the Spirit, and the diversity
of his gifts, C.iv.1-16</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.i-p9">2.The difference between their former and
their present state, 17- 24</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xi.i-p10">2. Particular To avoid,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.i-p11">1. Lying, 25</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.i-p12">2. Anger, 26, 27</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.i-p13">3. Theft, 28</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.i-p14">4. Corrupt communication, 29, 30</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.i-p15">5. Bitterness, 31- 5. 2</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.i-p16">6. Uncleanness, 3-14</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.i-p17">7. Drunkenness, 15-21 With a commendation of
the opposite virtues To do their duty, as,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xi.i-p18">1. Wives and husbands, 22-33</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xi.i-p19">2. Children and parents, vi. 1-4</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xi.i-p20">3. Servants and masters, 5-9</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xi.i-p21">3. Final: to war the spiritual warfare,
10-20</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xi.i-p22">IV. The conclusion, 21-24</p>
<h2 id="i.xi.i-p22.1">EPHESIANS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="18.85%" prev="i.xi.i" next="i.xi.iii" id="i.xi.ii">
<h3 id="i.xi.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Eph. I" id="i.xi.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Eph|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.1" /> 

<p id="i.xi.ii-p1">1. By the will of God - Not by any merit of my own. To the
saints who are at Ephesus - And in all the adjacent places. For this
epistle is not directed to the Ephesians only, but likewise to all the
other churches of Asia.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p2">3. Blessed be the God and Father of our Lord Jesus Christ,
who hath blessed us - God's blessing us is his bestowing all spiritual
and heavenly blessings upon us. Our blessing God is the paying him our
solemn and grateful acknowledgments, both on account of his own
essential blessedness, and of the blessings which he bestows upon us. He
is the God of our Lord Jesus Christ, as man and Mediator: he is his
Father, primarily, with respect to his divine nature, as his only
begotten Son; and, secondarily, with respect to his human nature, as
that is personally united to the divine. With all spiritual blessings in
heavenly things - With all manner of spiritual blessings, which are
heavenly in their nature, original, and tendency, and shall be completed
in heaven: far different from the external privileges of the Jews, and
the earthly blessings they expected from the Messiah.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p3">4. As he hath chosen us - Both Jews and gentiles, whom he
foreknew as believing in Christ, <scripRef passage="1 Pet. i. 2" id="i.xi.ii-p3.1" parsed="|1Pet|1|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.1.2">1 Pet.
i, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p4">5. Having predestinated us to the adoption of sons - Having
foreordained that all who afterwards believed should enjoy the dignity
of being sons of God, and joint-heirs with Christ. According to the good
pleasure of his will - According to his free, fixed, unalterable purpose
to confer this blessing on all those who should believe in Christ, and
those only.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p5">6. To the praise of the glory of his grace - His glorious,
free love without any desert on our part.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p6">7. By whom we - Who believe. Have - From the moment we
believe. Redemption - From the guilt and power of sin. Through his blood
- Through what he hath done and suffered for us. According to the riches
of his grace - According to the abundant overflowings of his free mercy
and favour.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p7">8. In all wisdom - Manifested by God in the whole scheme of
our salvation. And prudence - Which be hath wrought in us, that we may
know and do all his acceptable and perfect will.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p8">9. Having made known to us - By his word and by his Spirit.
The mystery of his will - The gracious scheme of salvation by faith,
which depends on his own sovereign will alone. This was but darkly
discovered under the law; is now totally hid from unbelievers; and has
heights and depths which surpass all the knowledge even of true
believers.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p9">10. That in the dispensation of the fulness of the times -
In this last administration of God's fullest grace, which took place
when the time appointed was fully come. He might gather together into
one in Christ - Might recapitulate, re-unite, and place in order again
under Christ, their common Head. All things which are in heaven, and on
earth - All angels and men, whether living or dead, in the Lord.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p10">11. Through whom we - Jews. Also have obtained an
inheritance - The glorious inheritance of the heavenly Canaan, to which,
when believers, we were predestinated according to the purpose of him
that worketh all things after the counsel of his own will - The
unalterable decree, "He that believeth shall be delivered;" which will
is not an arbitrary will, but flowing from the rectitude of his nature,
else, what security would there be that it would be his will to keep his
word even with the elect?</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p11">12. That we - Jews. Who first believed - Before the
gentiles. So did some of them in every place. Here is another branch of
the true gospel predestination: he that believes is not only elected to
salvation, (if he endures to the end,) but is fore-appointed of God to
walk in holiness, to the praise of his glory.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p12">13. In whom ye - Gentiles. Likewise believed, after ye had
heard the gospel - Which God made the means of your salvation; in whom
after ye had believed - Probably some time after their first believing.
Ye were sealed by that Holy Spirit of promise - Holy both in his nature
and in his operations, and promised to all the children of God. The
sealing seems to imply,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.ii-p13">1. A full impression of the image of God on
their souls.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.ii-p14">2. A full assurance of receiving all the
promises, whether relating to time or eternity.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p15">14. Who, thus sealing us, is an earnest - Both a pledge and
a foretaste of our inheritance. Till the redemption of the purchased
possession - Till the church, which he has purchased with his own blood,
shall be fully delivered from all sin and sorrow, and advanced to
everlasting glory. To the praise of his glory - Of his glorious wisdom,
power, and mercy.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p16">15. Since I heard of your faith and love - That is, of
their perseverance and increase therein.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p17">16. I cease not - In all my solemn addresses to God. To
give thanks for you, making mention of you in my prayers - So he did of
all the churches, <scripRef passage="Col. i. 9" id="i.xi.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Col|1|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.1.9">Col. i,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p18">17. That the Father of that infinite glory which shines in
the face of Christ, from whom also we receive the glorious inheritance,
ver. 18, may give you the Spirit of wisdom and Revelation - The same who
is the Spirit of promise is also, in the progress of the faithful, the
Spirit of wisdom and Revelation; making them wise unto salvation, and
revealing to them the deep things of God. He is here speaking of that
wisdom and Revelation which are common to all real Christians.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p19">18. The eyes of your understanding - It is with these alone
that we discern the things of God. Being first opened, and then
enlightened - By his Spirit. That ye may know what is the hope of his
calling - That ye may experimentally and delightfully know what are the
blessings which God has called you to hope for by his word and his
Spirit. And what is the riches of the glory of his inheritance in the
saints - What an immense treasure of blessedness he hath provided as an
inheritance for holy souls.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p20">19. And what the exceeding greatness of his power toward us
who believe - Both in quickening our dead souls, and preserving them in
spiritual life. According to the power which he exerted in Christ,
raising him from the dead - By the very same almighty power whereby he
raised Christ; for no less would suffice.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p21">20. And he hath seated him at his own right hand - That is,
he hath exalted him in his human nature, as a recompence for his
sufferings, to a quiet, everlasting possession of all possible
blessedness, majesty, and glory.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p22">21. Far above all principality, and power, and might, and
dominion - That is, God hath invested him with uncontrollable authority
over all demons in hell, all angels in heaven, and all the princes and
potentates on earth. And every name that is named - We know the king is
above all, though we cannot name all the officers of his court. So we
know that Christ is above all, though we are not able to name all his
subjects. Not only in this world, but also in that which is to come -
The world to come is so styled, not because it does not yet exist, but
because it is not yet visible. Principalities and powers are named now;
but those also who are not even named in this world, but shall be
revealed in the world to come, are all subject to Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p23">22. And he hath given him to be head over all things to the
church - An head both of guidance and government, and likewise of life
and influence, to the whole and every member of it. All these stand in
the nearest union with him, and have as continual and effectual a
communication of activity, growth, and strength from him, as the natural
body from its head.</p>

<p id="i.xi.ii-p24">23. The fulness of him that filleth all in all - It is hard
to say in what sense this can be spoken of the church; but the sense is
easy and natural, if we refer it to Christ, who is the fulness of the
Father.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="18.99%" prev="i.xi.ii" next="i.xi.iv" id="i.xi.iii">
<h3 id="i.xi.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Eph. II" id="i.xi.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Eph|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.2" /> 

<p id="i.xi.iii-p1">1. And he hath quickened you - In the nineteenth and
twentieth verses of the preceding chapter, St. Paul spoke of God's
working in them by the same almighty power whereby he raised Christ from
the dead. On the mention of this he, in the fulness of his heart, runs
into a flow of thought concerning the glory of Christ's exaltation in
the three following verses. He here resumes the thread of his discourse.
Who were dead - Not only diseased, but dead; absolutely void of all
spiritual life; and as incapable of quickening yourselves, as persons
literally dead. In trespasses and sins-Sins seem to be spoken chiefly of
the gentiles, who knew not God; trespasses, of the Jews, who had his
law, and yet regarded it not, ver. 5. The latter herein obeyed the
flesh; the former, the prince of the power of the air.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p2">2. According to the course of this world - The word
translated course properly means a long series of times, wherein one
corrupt age follows another. According to the prince of the power of the
air - The effect of which power all may perceive, though all do not
understand the cause of it: a power unspeakably penetrating and widely
diffused; but yet, as to its baneful influences, beneath the orb of
believers. The evil spirits are united under one head, the seat of whose
dominion is in the air. Here he sometimes raises storms, sometimes makes
visionary representations, and is continually roving to and fro. The
spirit that now worketh - With mighty power; and so he did, and doth in
all ages. In the sons of disobedience - In all who do not believe and
obey the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p3">3. Among whom we - Jews. Also, formerly had our
conversation: doing the will of the flesh - In gross, brutal sins. And
of the mind - By spiritual, diabolical wickedness. In the former clause,
flesh denotes the whole evil nature; in the latter, the body opposed to
the soul. And were by nature - That is, in our natural state. Children
of wrath - Having the wrath of God abiding on us, even as the gentiles.
This expression, by nature, occurs also, <scripRef passage="Gal. iv. 8" id="i.xi.iii-p3.1" parsed="|Gal|4|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.4.8">Gal. iv, 8</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Rom. ii. 14" id="i.xi.iii-p3.2" parsed="|Rom|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.2.14">Rom. ii, 14</scripRef>; and thrice in the eleventh chapter. But in none of these
places does it signify, by custom, or practice, or customary practice,
as a late writer affirms. Nor can it mean so here For this would make
the apostle guilty of gross tautology, their customary sinning having
been expressed already, in the former part of the verse. But all these
passages agree in expressing what belongs to the nature of the persons
spoken of.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p4">4. Mercy removes misery: love confers salvation.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p5">5. He hath quickened us together with Christ - In
conformity to him, and by virtue of our union with him. By grace ye are
saved - Grace is both the beginning and end. The apostle speaks
indifferently either in the first or second person; the Jews and
gentiles being in the same circumstance, both by nature and by grace.
This text lays the axe to the very root of spiritual pride, and all
glorying in ourselves. Therefore St. Paul, foreseeing the backwardness
of mankind to receive it, yet knowing the absolute necessity of its
being received, again asserts the very same truth, ver. 8, in the very
same words.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p6">6. And hath raised us up together - Both Jews and gentiles
already in spirit; and ere long our bodies too will be raised. And made
us all sit together in heavenly places - This is spoken by way of
anticipation. Believers are not yet possessed of their seats in heaven;
but each of them has a place prepared for him.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p7">7. The ages to come - That is, all succeeding ages.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p8">8. By grace ye are saved through faith - Grace, without any
respect to human worthiness, confers the glorious gift. Faith, with an
empty hand, and without any pretense to personal desert, receives the
heavenly blessing. And this is not of yourselves - This refers to the
whole preceding clause, That ye are saved through faith, is the gift of
God.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p9">9. Not by works - Neither this faith nor this salvation is
owing to any works you ever did, will, or can do.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p10">10. For we are his workmanship - Which proves both that
salvation is by faith, and that faith is the gift of God. Created unto
good works - That afterwards we might give ourselves to them. Which God
had before preprepared - The occasions of them: so we must still ascribe
the whole to God. That we might walk in them - Though not be justified
by them.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p11">11. Wherefore remember - Such a remembrance strengthens
faith, and increases gratitude. That ye being formerly gentiles in the
flesh - Neither circumcised in body nor in spirit. Who were accordingly
called the uncircumcision - By way of reproach. By that which is called
the circumcision - By those who call themselves the circumcised, and
think this a proof that they are the people of God; and who indeed have
that outward circumcision which is performed by hands in the flesh.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p12">12. Were at that time without Christ - Having no faith in,
or knowledge of, him. Being aliens from the commonwealth of Israel -
Both as to their temporal privileges and spiritual blessings. And
strangers to the covenants of promise - The great promise in both the
Jewish and Christian covenant was the Messiah. Having no hope - Because
they had no promise whereon to ground their hope. And being without God
- Wholly ignorant of the true God, and so in effect atheists. Such in
truth are, more or less, all men, in all ages, till they know God by the
teaching of his own Spirit. In the world - The wide, vain world, wherein
ye wandered up and down, unholy and unhappy.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p13">13. Far off - From God and his people. Nigh - Intimately
united to both.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p14">14. For he is our peace - Not only as he purchased it, but
as he is the very bond and center of union. He who hath made both - Jews
and gentiles, one church. The apostle describes,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.iii-p15">1. The conjunction of the gentiles with
Israel, ver. 14, 15. And,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xi.iii-p16">2. The conjunction of both with God, ver.
15-18. Each description is subdivided into two parts. And the former
part of the one, concerning abolishing the enmity, answers the former
part of the other; the latter part of the one, concerning the
evangelical decrees, the latter part of the other. And hath broken down
the middle wall of partition - Alluding to that wall of old, which
separated the court of Israel from the court of the gentiles. Such a
wall was the ceremonial law, which Christ had now taken away.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p17">15. Having abolished by his suffering in the flesh the
cause of enmity between the Jews and gentiles, even the law of
ceremonial commandments, through his decrees - Which offer mercy to all;
see <scripRef passage="Colossians ii. 14" id="i.xi.iii-p17.1" parsed="|Col|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.2.14">Colossians ii, 14</scripRef>. That he might form the two - Jew and gentile. Into one new
man - one mystical body.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p18">16. In one body - One church. Having slain - By his own
death on the cross. The enmity - Which had been between sinners and
God.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p19">17. And he came - After his resurrection. And preached
peace - By his ministers and his Spirit. To you - Gentiles. That were
afar off - At the utmost distance from God. And to them that were nigh -
To the Jews, who were comparatively nigh, being his visible church.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p20">18. For through him, we both - Jews and gentiles. Have
access - Liberty of approaching, by the guidance and aid of one Spirit
to God as our Father. Christ, the Spirit, and the Father, the three-one
God, stand frequently in the same order.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p21">19. Therefore ye are no longer strangers, but citizens of
the heavenly Jerusalem; no longer foreigners, but received into the very
family of God.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p22">20. And are built upon the foundation of the apostles and
prophets - As the foundation sustains the building, so the word of God,
declared by the apostles and prophets, sustains the faith of all
believers. God laid the foundation by them; but Christ himself is the
chief corner-stone of the foundation. Elsewhere he is termed the
foundation itself, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. iii. 11" id="i.xi.iii-p22.1" parsed="|1Cor|3|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.3.11">1 Cor. iii,
11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iii-p23">21. On whom all the building fitly framed together - The
whole fabric of the universal church rises up like a great pile of
living materials. Into an holy temple in the Lord - Dedicated to Christ,
and inhabited by him, in which he displays his presence, and is
worshipped and glorified. What is the temple of Diana of the Ephesians,
whom ye formerly worshipped, to this?</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="19.13%" prev="i.xi.iii" next="i.xi.v" id="i.xi.iv">
<h3 id="i.xi.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Eph. III" id="i.xi.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Eph|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.3" /> 

<p id="i.xi.iv-p1">1. For this cause - That ye may be so "built together," I
am a prisoner for you gentiles - For your advantage, and for asserting
your right to these blessings. This it was which so enraged the Jews
against him.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p2">2. The dispensation of the grace of God given me in your
behalf - That is, the commission to dispense the gracious gospel; to you
gentiles in particular. This they had heard from his own mouth.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p3">3. The mystery - Of salvation by Christ alone, and that
both to Jews and gentiles. As I wrote before - Namely, chap. i, 9, 10;
the very words of which passage he here repeats.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p4">5. Which in other - In former, ages was not so clearly or
fully made known to the sons of men - To any man, no, not to Ezekiel, so
often styled, "son of man;" nor to any of the ancient prophets. Those
here spoken of are New Testament prophets.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p5">6. That the gentiles are joint-heirs - Of God. And of the
same body - Under Christ the head. And joint-partakers of his promise -
The communion of the Holy Ghost.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p6">7. According to the gift of the grace of God - That is, the
apostle- ship which he hath graciously given me, and which he hath
qualified me for. By the effectual working of his power - In me and by
me.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p7">8. Unto me, who am less than the least of all saints, is
this grace given - Here are the noblest strains of eloquence to paint
the exceeding low opinion the apostle had of himself, and the fulness of
unfathomable blessings which are treasured up in Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p8">9. What is the fellowship of the mystery - What those
mysterious blessings are whereof all believers jointly partake. Which
was, in a great measure, hidden from eternity by God, who, to make way
for the free exercise of his love, created all things - This is the
foundation of all his dispensations.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p9">10. That the manifold wisdom of God might be made known by
the church - By what is done in the church, which is the theatre of the
divine wisdom.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p10">12. By whom we have free access - Such as those petitioners
have, who are introduced to the royal presence by some distinguished
favourite. And boldness - Unrestrained liberty of speech, such as
children use in addressing an indulgent father, when, without fear of
offending, they disclose all their wants, and make known all their
requests.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p11">13. The not fainting is your glory.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p12">15. Of whom - The Father. The whole family of angels in
heaven, saints in paradise, and believers on earth is named. Being the
"children of God," (a more honourable title than "children of Abraham,")
and depending on him as the Father of the family.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p13">16. The riches of his glory - The immense fulness of his
glorious wisdom, power, and mercy. The inner man - The soul.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p14">17. Dwell - That is, constantly and sensibly abide.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p15">18. That being rooted and grounded - That is, deeply fixed
and firmly established, in love. Ye may comprehend - So far as an human
mind is capable. What is the breadth of the love of Christ - Embracing
all mankind. And length - From everlasting to everlasting. And depth -
Not to be fathomed by any creature. And height - Not to be reached by
any enemy.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p16">19. And to know - But the apostle corrects himself, and
immediately observes, it cannot be fully known. This only we know, that
the love of Christ surpasses all knowledge. That ye may be filled -
Which is the sum of all. With all the fulness of God - With all his
light, love, wisdom, holiness, power, and glory. A perfection far beyond
a bare freedom from sin.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p17">20. Now to him - This doxology is admirably adapted to
strengthen our faith, that we may not stagger at the great things the
apostle has been praying for, as if they were too much for God to give,
or for us to expect from him. That is able - Here is a most beautiful
gradation. When he has given us exceeding, yea, abundant blessings,
still we may ask for more. And he is able to do it. But we may think of
more than we have asked. He is able to do this also. Yea, and above all
this. Above all we ask - Above all we can think. Nay, exceedingly,
abundantly above all that we can either ask or think.</p>

<p id="i.xi.iv-p18">21. In the church - On earth and in heaven.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="19.20%" prev="i.xi.iv" next="i.xi.vi" id="i.xi.v">
<h3 id="i.xi.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Eph. IV" id="i.xi.v-p0.2" parsed="|Eph|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.4" /> 

<p id="i.xi.v-p1">1. I therefore, the prisoner of the Lord - Imprisoned for
his sake and for your sakes; for the sake of the gospel which he had
preached amongst them. This was therefore a powerful motive to them to
comfort him under it by their obedience.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p2">3. endeavouring to keep the unity of the Spirit - That
mutual union and harmony, which is a fruit of the Spirit. The bond of
peace is love.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p3">4. There is one body - The universal church, all believers
throughout the world. One Spirit, one Lord, one God and Father - The
ever-blessed Trinity. One hope - Of heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p4">5. One outward baptism.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p5">6. One God and Father of all - That believe. Who is above
all - Presiding over all his children, operating through them all by
Christ, and dwelling in all by his Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p6">7. According to the measure of the gift of Christ -
According as Christ is pleased to give to each.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p7">8. Wherefore he saith - That is, in reference to which God
saith by David, Having ascended on high, he led captivity captive - He
triumphed over all his enemies, Satan, sin, and death, which had before
enslaved all the world: alluding to the custom of ancient conquerors,
who led those they had conquered in chains after them. And, as they also
used to give donatives to the people, at their return from victory, so
he gave gifts to men - Both the ordinary and extraordinary gifts of the
Spirit. <scripRef passage="Psalm lxviii. 18" id="i.xi.v-p7.1" parsed="|Ps|68|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.68.18">Psalm lxviii,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p8">9. Now this expression, He ascended, what is it, but that
he descended - That is, does it not imply, that he descended first?
Certainly it does, on the supposition of his being God. Otherwise it
would not: since all the saints will ascend to heaven, though none of
them descended thence. Into the lower parts of the earth - So the womb
is called, <scripRef passage="Psalm cxxxix. 5" id="i.xi.v-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|139|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.139.5">Psalm cxxxix,
5</scripRef>; the grave, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxiii. 9" id="i.xi.v-p8.2" parsed="|Ps|63|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.63.9">Psalm lxiii,
9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p9">10. He that descended - That thus amazingly humbled
himself. Is the same that ascended - That was so highly exalted. That he
might fill all things - The whole church, with his Spirit, presence, and
operations.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p10">11. And, among other his free gifts, he gave some apostles
- His chief ministers and special witnesses, as having seen him after
his resurrection, and received their commission immediately from him.
And same prophets, and some evangelists - A prophet testifies of things
to come; an evangelist of things past: and that chiefly by preaching the
gospel before or after any of the apostles. All these were extraordinary
officers. The ordinary were. Some pastors - Watching over their several
flocks. And some teachers - Whether of the same or a lower order, to
assist them, as occasion might require.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p11">12. In this verse is noted the office of ministers; in the
next, the aim of the saints; in the 14th, 15th, 16th, the way of growing
in grace. And each of these has three parts, standing in the same order.
For the perfecting the saints - The completing them both in number and
their various gifts and graces. To the work of the ministry - The
serving God and his church in their various ministrations. To the
edifying of the body of Christ - The building up this his mystical body
in faith, love, holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p12">13. Till we all - And every one of us. Come to the unity of
the faith, and knowledge of the Son of God - To both an exact agreement
in the Christian doctrine, and an experimental knowledge of Christ as
the Son of God. To a perfect man - To a state of spiritual manhood both
in understanding and strength. To the measure of the stature of the
fulness of Christ - To that maturity of age and spiritual stature
wherein we shall be filled with Christ, so that he will be all in
all.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p13">14. Fluctuating to and fro - From within, even when there
is no wind. And carried about with every wind - From without; when we
are assaulted by others, who are unstable as the wind. By the sleight of
men - By their "cogging the dice;" so the original word implies.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p14">15. Into him - Into his image and Spirit, and into a full
union with him.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p15">16. From whom the whole mystical body fitly joined together
- All the parts being fitted for and adapted to each other, and most
exactly harmonizing with the whole. And compacted - Knit and cemented
together with the utmost firmness. Maketh increase by that which every
joint supplieth - Or by the mutual help of every joint. According to the
effectual working in the measure of every member - According as every
member in its measure effectually works for the support and growth of
the whole. A beautiful allusion to the human body, composed of different
joints and members, knit together by various ligaments, and furnished
with vessels of communication from the head to every part.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p16">17. This therefore I say - He returns thither where he
begun, ver. 1. And testify in the Lord - In the name and by the
authority of the Lord Jesus. In the vanity of their mind - Having lost
the knowledge of the true God, <scripRef passage="Rom. i. 21" id="i.xi.v-p16.1" parsed="|Rom|1|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.1.21">Rom. i,
21</scripRef>. This is the root of all evil walking.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p17">18. Having their understanding darkened, through the
ignorance that is in them - So that they are totally void of the light
of God, neither have they any knowledge of his will. Being alienated
from the life of God - Utter strangers to the divine, the spiritual
life. Through the hardness of their hearts - Callous and senseless. And
where there is no sense, there can be no life.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p18">19. Who being past feeling - The original word is
peculiarly significant. It properly means, past feeling pain. Pain urges
the sick to seek a remedy, which, where there is no pain, is little
thought of. Have given themselves up - Freely, of their own accord.
Lasciviousness is but one branch of uncleanness, which implies impurity
of every kind.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p19">20. But ye have not so learned Christ - That is, ye cannot
act thus, now ye know him, since you know the Christian dispensation
allows of no sin.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p20">21. Seeing ye have heard him - Teaching you inwardly by his
Spirit. As the truth is in Jesus - According to his own gospel.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p21">22. The old man - That is, the whole body of sin. All
sinful desires are deceitful; promising the happiness which they cannot
give.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p22">23. The spirit of your mind - The very ground of your
heart.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p23">24. The new man - Universal holiness. After - In the very
image of God.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p24">25. Wherefore - Seeing ye are thus created anew, walk
accordingly, in every particular. For we are members one of another - To
which intimate union all deceit is quite repugnant.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p25">26. Be ye angry, and sin not - That is, if ye are angry,
take heed ye sin not. Anger at sin is not evil; but we should feel only
pity to the sinner. If we are angry at the person, as well as the fault,
we sin. And how hardly do we avoid it. Let not the sun go down upon your
wrath - Reprove your brother, and be reconciled immediately. Lose not
one day. A clear, express command. Reader, do you keep it?</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p26">27. Neither give place to the devil - By any delay.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p27">28. But rather let him labour - Lest idleness lead him to
steal again. And whoever has sinned in any kind ought the more zealously
to practice the opposite virtue. That he may have to give - And so be no
longer a burden and nuisance, but a blessing, to his neighbours.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p28">29. But that which is good - Profitable to the speaker and
hearers. To the use of edifying - To forward them in repentance, faith,
or holiness. That it may minister grace - Be a means of conveying more
grace into their hearts. Hence we learn, what discourse is corrupt, as
it were stinking in the nostrils of God; namely, all that is not
profitable, not edifying, not apt to minister grace to the hearers.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p29">30. Grieve not the Holy Spirit - By any disobedience.
Particularly by corrupt discourse; or by any of the following sins. Do
not force him to withdraw from you, as a friend does whom you grieve by
unkind behaviour. The day of redemption - That is, the day of judgment,
in which our redemption will be completed.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p30">31. Let all bitterness - The height of settled anger,
opposite to kindness, ver. 32. And wrath - Lasting displeasure toward
the ignorant, and them that are out of the way, opposite to
tenderheartedness. And anger - The very first risings of disgust at
those that injure you, opposite to forgiving one another. And clamour -
Or bawling. "I am not angry," says one; "but it is my way to speak so."
Then unlearn that way: it is the way to hell. And evil speaking - Be it
in ever so mild and soft a tone, or with ever such professions of
kindness. Here is a beautiful retrogradation, beginning with the
highest, and descending to the lowest, degree of the want of love.</p>

<p id="i.xi.v-p31">32. As God, showing himself kind and tenderhearted in the
highest degree, hath forgiven you.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="19.35%" prev="i.xi.v" next="i.xi.vii" id="i.xi.vi">
<h3 id="i.xi.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Eph. V" id="i.xi.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Eph|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.5" /> 

<p id="i.xi.vi-p1">1. Be ye therefore followers - Imitators. Of God - In
forgiving and loving. O how much more honourable and more happy, to be
an imitator of God, than of Homer, Virgil, or Alexander the Great!</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p2">3. But let not any impure love be even named or heard of
among you - Keep at the utmost distance from it, as becometh saints.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p3">4. Nor foolish talking - Tittle tattle, talking of nothing,
the weather, fashions, meat and drink. Or jesting - The word properly
means, wittiness, facetiousness, esteemed by the heathens an half-
virtue. But how frequently even this quenches the Spirit, those who are
tender of conscience know. Which are not convenient - For a Christian;
as neither increasing his faith nor holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p4">6. Because of these things - As innocent as the heathens
esteem them, and as those dealers in vain words would persuade you to
think them.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p5">8. Ye were once darkness - Total blindness and ignorance.
Walk as children of light - Suitably to your present knowledge.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p6">9. The fruit of the light - Opposite to " the unfruitful
works of darkness," chap. iv, 11. Is in - That is, consists in. Goodness
and righteousness and truth - Opposite to the sins spoken of, chap. iv,
25,&amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p7">11. Reprove them - To avoid them is not enough.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p8">12. In secret - As flying the light.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p9">13. But all things which are reproved, are thereby dragged
out into the light, and made manifest - Shown in their proper colours,
by the light. For whatsoever doth make manifest is light - That is, for
nothing but light, yea, light from heaven, can make anything
manifest.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p10">14. Wherefore he - God. Saith - In the general tenor of his
word, to all who are still in darkness. Awake thou that steepest - In
ignorance of God and thyself; in stupid insensibility. And arise from
the dead - From the death of sin. And Christ shall give thee light -
Knowledge, holiness, happiness.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p11">15. Circumspectly - Exactly, with the utmost accuracy,
getting to the highest pitch of every point of holiness. Not as fools -
Who think not where they are going, or do not make the best of their
way.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p12">16. With all possible care redeeming the time - Saving all
you can for the best purposes; buying every possible moment out of the
hands of sin and Satan; out of the hands of sloth, ease, pleasure,
worldly business; the more diligently, because the present are evil
days, days of the grossest ignorance, immorality, and profaneness.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p13">17. What the will of the Lord is - In every time, place,
and circumstance.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p14">18. Wherein is excess - That is, which leads to debauchery
of every kind. But be ye filled with the Spirit - In all his graces, who
gives a more noble pleasure than wine can do.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p15">19. Speaking to each other - By the Spirit. In the Psalms -
Of David. And hymns - Of praise. And spiritual songs - On any divine
subject. By there being no inspired songs, peculiarly adapted to the
Christian dispensation, as there were to the Jewish, it is evident that
the promise of the Holy Ghost to believers, in the last days, was by his
larger effusion to supply the lack of it. Singing with your hearts - As
well as your voice. To the Lord - Jesus, who searcheth the heart.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p16">20. Giving thanks - At all times and places. And for all
things - Prosperous or adverse, since all work together for good. In the
name of, or through, our Lord Jesus Christ - By whom we receive all good
things.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p17">22. In the following directions concerning relative duties,
the inferiors are all along placed before the superiors, because the
general proposition is concerning submission; and inferiors ought to do
their duty, whatever their superiors do. Wives, submit yourselves to
your own husbands - Unless where God forbids. Otherwise, in all
indifferent things, the will of the husband is a law to the wife. As
unto the Lord - The obedience a wife pays to her husband is at the same
time paid to Christ himself; he being head of the wife, as Christ is
head of the church.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p18">23. The head - The governor, guide, and guardian of the
wife. And he is the saviour of the body - The church, from all sin and
misery.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p19">24. In everything - Which is not contrary to any command of
God.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p20">25. Even as Christ loved the church - Here is the true
model of conjugal affection. With this kind of affection, with this
degree of it, and to this end, should husbands love their wives.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p21">26. That he might sanctify it through the word - The
ordinary channel of all blessings. Having cleansed it - From the guilt
and power of sin. By the washing of water - In baptism; if, with "the
outward and visible sign," we receive the "inward and spiritual
grace."</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p22">27. That he might present it - Even in this world. To
himself - As his spouse. A glorious church - All glorious within. Not
having spot - Of impurity from any sin. Or wrinkle - Of deformity from
any decay.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p23">28. As their own bodies - That is, as themselves. He that
loveth his wife loveth himself - Which is not a sin, but an indisputable
duty.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p24">29. His own flesh - That is, himself. Nourisheth and
cherisheth - That is, feeds and clothes it.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p25">30. For we - The reason why Christ nourishes and cherishes
the church is, that close connection between them which is here
expressed in the words of Moses, originally spoken concerning Eve. Are
members - Are as intimately united to Christ, in a spiritual sense, as
if we were literally "flesh of his flesh, and bone of his bone."</p>

<p id="i.xi.vi-p26">31. For this cause - Because of this intimate union. <scripRef passage="Gen. ii. 24" id="i.xi.vi-p26.1" parsed="|Gen|2|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.2.24">Gen. ii, 24</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="19.45%" prev="i.xi.vi" next="i.xii" id="i.xi.vii">
<h3 id="i.xi.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Eph. VI" id="i.xi.vii-p0.2" parsed="|Eph|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.6" /> 

<p id="i.xi.vii-p1">1. Children, obey your parents - In all things lawful. The
will of the parent is a law to the child. In the Lord - For his sake.
For this is right - Manifestly just and reasonable.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p2">2. honour - That is, love, reverence, obey, assist, in all
things. The mother is particularly mentioned, as being more liable to be
slighted than the father. Which is the first commandment with a promise
- For the promise implied in the second commandment does not belong to
the keeping that command in particular, but the whole law. <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 12" id="i.xi.vii-p2.1" parsed="|Exod|20|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.12">Exod. xx, 12</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p3">3. That thou mayest live long upon the earth - This is
usually fulfilled to eminently dutiful children; and he who lives long
and well has a long seed-time for the eternal harvest. But this promise,
in the Christian dispensation, is to be understood chiefly in a more
exalted and Spiritual sense.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p4">4. And, ye fathers - Mothers are included; but fathers are
named, as being more apt to be stern and severe. Provoke not your
children to wrath - Do not needlessly fret or exasperate them. But bring
them up - With all tenderness and mildness. In the instruction and
discipline of the Lord - Both in Christian knowledge and practice.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p5">5. Your masters according to the flesh - According to the
present state of things: afterward the servant is free from his master.
With fear and trembling - A proverbial expression, implying the utmost
care and diligence. In singleness of heart - With a single eye to the
providence and will of God.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p6">6. Not with eye-service - Serving them better when under
their eye than at other times. But doing the will of God from the heart
- Doing whatever you do, as the will of God, and with your might.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p7">7. Unto the Lord, and not to men - That is, rather than to
men; and by making every action of common life a sacrifice to God;
having an eye to him in all things, even as if there were no other
master.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p8">8. He shall receive the same - That is, a full and adequate
recompence for it.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p9">9. Do the same things to them - That is, act toward them
from the same principle. Forbearing threatening - Behaving with
gentleness and humanity, not in a harsh or domineering way.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p10">10. Brethren - This is the only place in this epistle where
he uses this compellation. Soldiers frequently use it to each other in
the field. Be strong - Nothing less will suffice for such a fight: to be
weak, and remain so, is the way to perish. In the power of his might - A
very uncommon expression, plainly denoting what great assistance we need
as if his might would not do, it must be the powerful exertion of his
might.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p11">11. Put on the whole armour of God - The Greek word means a
complete suit of armour. Believers are said to put on the girdle,
breastplate, shoes; to take the shield of faith, and sword of the
Spirit. The whole armour - As if the armour would scarce do, it must be
the whole armour. This is repeated, ver. 13, because of the strength and
subtilty of our adversaries, and because of an "evil day" of sore trial
being at hand.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p12">12. For our wrestling is not only, not chiefly, against
flesh and blood - Weak men, or fleshly appetites. But against
principalities, against powers - The mighty princes of all the infernal
legions. And great is their power, and that likewise of those legions
whom they command. Against the rulers of the world - Perhaps these
principalities and powers remain mostly in the citadel of their kingdom
of darkness. But there are other evil spirits who range abroad, to whom
the provinces of the world are committed. Of the darkness - This is
chiefly spiritual darkness. Of this age - Which prevails during the
present state of things. Against wicked spirits - Who continually oppose
faith, love, holiness, either by force or fraud; and labour to infuse
unbelief, pride, idolatry malice, envy, anger, hatred. In heavenly
places - Which were once their abode, and which they still aspire to, as
far as they are permitted.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p13">13. In the evil day - The war is perpetual; but the fight
is one day less, another more, violent. The evil day is either at the
approach of death, or in life; may be longer or shorter and admits of
numberless varieties. And having done all, to stand - That ye may still
keep on your armour, still stand upon your guard, still watch and pray;
and thus ye will be enabled to endure unto the end, and stand with joy
before the face of the Son of Man.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p14">14. Having your loins girt about - That ye may be ready for
every motion. With truth - Not only with the truths of the gospel, but
with "truth in the inward parts;" for without this all our knowledge of
divine truth will prove but a poor girdle "in the evil day." So our Lord
is described, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xi. 5" id="i.xi.vii-p14.1" parsed="|Isa|11|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.11.5">Isaiah xi, 5</scripRef>. And as a girded man is always ready to go on, so this seems
to intimate an obedient heart, a ready will. Our Lord adds to the loins
girded, the lights burning, <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 35" id="i.xi.vii-p14.2" parsed="|Luke|12|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.35">Luke xii, 35</scripRef>; showing that watching and ready obedience are the
inseparable companions of faith and love. And having on the breastplate
of righteousness - The righteousness of a spotless purity, in which
Christ will present us faultless before God, through the merit of his
own blood. With this breastplate our Lord is described, <scripRef passage="Isaiah lix. 17" id="i.xi.vii-p14.3" parsed="|Isa|59|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.59.17">Isaiah lix, 17</scripRef>. In the breast is the seat of conscience, which is guarded
by righteousness. No armour for the back is mentioned. We are always to
face our enemies.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p15">15. And your feet shod with the preparation of the gospel -
Let this be always ready to direct and confirm you in every step. This
part of the armour, for the feet, is needful, considering what a journey
we have to go; what a race to run. Our feet must be so shod, that our
footsteps slip not. To order our life and conversation aright, we are
prepared by the gospel blessing, the peace and love of God ruling in the
heart, <scripRef passage="Colossians iii. 14, 15" id="i.xi.vii-p15.1" parsed="|Col|3|14|3|15" osisRef="Bible:Col.3.14-Col.3.15">Colossians iii, 14,
15</scripRef>. By this only can we tread the rough ways, surmount our
difficulties, and hold out to the end.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p16">16. Above or over all - As a sort of universal covering to
every other part of the armour itself, continually exercise a strong and
lively faith. This you may use as a shield, which will quench all the
fiery darts, the furious temptations, violent and sudden injections of
the devil.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p17">17. And take for an helmet the hope of salvation - <scripRef passage="1 Thess. v. 8" id="i.xi.vii-p17.1" parsed="|1Thess|5|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.5.8">1 Thess. v, 8</scripRef>. The head is that part which is most carefully to be
defended. One stroke here may prove fatal. The armour for this is the
hope of salvation. The lowest degree of this hope is a confidence that
God will work the whole work of faith in us; the highest is a full
assurance of future glory, added to the experimental knowledge of
pardoning love. Armed with this helmet, the hope of the joy set before
him, Christ "endured the cross, and despised the shame," <scripRef passage="Heb. xii. 2" id="i.xi.vii-p17.2" parsed="|Heb|12|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.12.2">Heb. xii,
2</scripRef>. And the sword of the Spirit, the word of God - This Satan
cannot withstand, when it is edged and wielded by faith. Till now our
armour has been only defensive. But we are to attack Satan, as well as
secure ourselves; the shield in one hand, and the sword in the other.
Whoever fights with the powers of hell will need both. He that is
covered with armour from head to foot, and neglects this, will be foiled
after all. This whole description shows us how great a thing it is to be
a Christian. The want of any one thing makes him incomplete. Though he
has his loins girt with truth, righteousness for a breastplate, his feet
shod with the preparation of the gospel, the shield of faith, the helmet
of salvation, and the sword of the Spirit; yet one thing he wants after
all. What is that? It follows,</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p18">18. Praying always - At all times, and on every occasion,
in midst of all employments, inwardly praying without ceasing. By the
Spirit - Through the influence of the Holy Spirit. With all prayer -
With all sort of prayer, public, private, mental, vocal. Some are
careful in respect of one kind of prayer, and negligent in others. If we
would have the petitions we ask, let us use all. Some there are who use
only mental prayer or ejaculations, and think they are in a state of
grace, and use a way of worship, far superior to any other: but such
only fancy themselves to be above what is really above them; it
requiring far more grace to be enabled to pour out a fervent and
continued prayer, than to offer up mental aspirations. And supplication
- Repeating and urging our prayer, as Christ did in the garden. And
watching - Inwardly attending on God, to know his will, to gain power to
do it, and to attain to the blessings we desire. With all perseverance -
Continuing to the end in this holy exercise. And supplication for all
the saints - Wrestling in fervent, continued intercession for others,
especially for the faithful, that they may do all the will of God, and
be steadfast to the end. Perhaps we receive few answers to prayer,
because we do not intercede enough for others.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p19">19. By the opening my mouth - Removing every inward and
every outward hindrance.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p20">20. An ambassador in bonds - The ambassadors of men usually
appear in great pomp. How differently does the ambassador of Christ
appear!</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p21">21. Ye also - As well as others.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p22">22. That he might comfort your hearts - By relating the
supports I find from God, and the success of the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p23">23. Peace - This verse recapitulates the whole epistle.</p>

<p id="i.xi.vii-p24">24. In sincerity - Or in incorruption; without corrupting
his genuine gospel, without any mixture of corrupt affections. And that
with continuance, till grace issue in glory.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE PHILIPPIANS" progress="19.61%" prev="i.xi.vii" next="i.xii.i" id="i.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Phil" id="i.xii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xii-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE PHILIPPIANS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Philippians" progress="19.62%" prev="i.xii" next="i.xii.ii" id="i.xii.i">

<p id="i.xii.i-p1">PHILIPPI was so called from Philip, king of Macedonia, who
much enlarged and beautified it. Afterwards it became a Roman colony,
and the chief city of that part of Macedonia. Hither St. Paul was sent
by a vision to preach and here, not long after his coming, he was
shamefully entreated. Nevertheless many were converted by him, during
the short time of his abode there; by whose liberality he was more
assisted than by any other church of his planting. And they had now sent
large assistance to him by Epaphroditus; by whom he returns them this
epistle. It contains six parts:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xii.i-p2">I. The inscription, Chap. i. 1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xii.i-p3">II. Thanksgiving and prayers for them,
3-11</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xii.i-p4">III.He relates his present state and good
hope: 12-24 Whence he exhorts them,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xii.i-p5">1. While he remains with them to walk worthy
of the gospel, 25- 30 ii. 1-16</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xii.i-p6">2. Though he should be killed, to rejoice
with him, 17, 18 And promises,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xii.i-p7">1. To certify them of all things by
Timotheus, 19-24</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xii.i-p8">2. In the mean time to send Epaphroditus,
25-30</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xii.i-p9">IV. He exhorts them to rejoice, iii. 1-3
admonishing them to beware of false teachers, and to imitate the true,
2-21 commending concord, iv. 1-3 He again exhorts them to joy and
meekness 4-7 and to whatsoever things are excellent, 8-9</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xii.i-p10">V. He accepts of their liberality, 10-20</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xii.i-p11">VI. The conclusion, 21-23</p>
<h2 id="i.xii.i-p11.1">PHILIPPIANS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="19.64%" prev="i.xii.i" next="i.xii.iii" id="i.xii.ii">
<h3 id="i.xii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Phil. I" id="i.xii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Phil|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.1" /> 

<p id="i.xii.ii-p1">1. Servants - St. Paul, writing familiarly to the
Philippians, does not style himself an apostle. And under the common
title of servants, he tenderly and modestly joins with himself his son
Timotheus, who had come to Philippi not long after St. Paul had received
him, <scripRef passage="Acts xvi. 3, 12" id="i.xii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Acts|16|3|0|0;|Acts|16|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.16.3 Bible:Acts.16.12">Acts xvi, 3, 12</scripRef>. To all the saints - The apostolic epistles were sent more
directly to the churches, than to the pastors of them. With the bishops
and deacons - The former properly took care of the internal state, the
latter, of the externals, of the church, <scripRef passage="1 Tim. iii. 2-8" id="i.xii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|1Tim|3|2|3|8" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.3.2-1Tim.3.8">1 Tim.
iii, 2-8</scripRef>; although these were not wholly confined to the one, neither
those to the other. The word bishops here includes all the presbyters at
Philippi, as well as the ruling presbyters: the names bishop and
presbyter, or elder, being promiscuously used in the first ages.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p2">4. With joy - After the epistle to the Ephesians, wherein
love reigns, follows this, wherein there is perpetual mention of joy.
"The fruit of the Spirit is love, joy." And joy peculiarly enlivens
prayer. The sum of the whole epistle is, I rejoice. Rejoice ye.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p3">5. The sense is, I thank God for your fellowship with us in
all the blessings of the gospel, which I have done from the first day of
your receiving it until now.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p4">6. Being persuaded - The grounds of which persuasion are
set down in the following verse. That he who hath begun a good work in
you, will perfect it until the day of Christ - That he who having
justified, hath begun to sanctify you, will carry on this work, till it
issue in glory.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p5">7. As it is right for me to think this of you all - Why? He
does not say, "Because of an eternal decree;" or, "Because a saint must
persevere;" but, because I have you in my heart, who were all partakers
of my grace - That is, because ye were all (for which I have you in my
heart, I bear you the most grateful and tender affection) partakers of
my grace - That is, sharers in the afflictions which God vouchsafed me
as a grace or favour, ver. 29, 30; both in my bonds, and when I was
called forth to answer for myself, and to confirm the gospel. It is not
improbable that, after they had endured that great trial of affliction,
God had sealed them unto full victory, of which the apostle had a
prophetic sight.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p6">8. I long for you with the bowels of Jesus Christ - In
Paul, not Paul lives, but Jesus Christ. Therefore he longs for them with
the bowels, the tenderness, not of Paul, but of Jesus Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p7">9. And this I pray, that your love - Which they had already
shown. May abound yet more and more - The fire which burned in the
apostle never says, It is enough. In knowledge and in all spiritual
sense - Which is the ground of all spiritual knowledge. We must be
inwardly sensible of divine peace, joy, love; otherwise, we cannot know
what they are.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p8">10. That ye may try - By that spiritual sense. The things
that are excellent - Not only good, but the very best; the superior
excellence of which is hardly discerned, but by the adult Christian.
That ye may be inwardly sincere - Having a single eye to the very best
things, and a pure heart. And outwardly without offense - Holy,
unblamable in all things.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p9">11. Being filled with the fruits of righteousness, which
are through Jesus Christ, to the glory and praise of God - Here are
three properties of that sincerity which is acceptable to God:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xii.ii-p10">1. It must bear fruits, the fruits of
righteousness, all inward and outward holiness, all good tempers, words,
and works; and that so abundantly, that we may be filled with them.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xii.ii-p11">2. The branch and the fruits must derive both
their virtue and their very being from the all - supporting, all -
supplying root, Jesus Christ.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xii.ii-p12">3. As all these flow from the grace of
Christ, so they must issue in the glory and praise of God.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p13">12. The things concerning me - My sufferings. Have fallen
out rather to the furtherance, than, as you feared, the hindrance, of
the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p14">13. My bonds in Christ - Endured for his sake. Have been
made manifest - Much taken notice of. In the whole palace - Of the Roman
emperor.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p15">14. And many - Who were before afraid. Trusting in the Lord
through my bonds - When they observed my constancy, and safety not
withstanding, are more bold.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p16">15, 16. Some indeed preach Christ out of contention -
Envying St. Paul's success, and striving to hurt him thereby. Not
sincerely - From a real desire to glorify God. But supposing - Though
they were disappointed. To add more affliction to my bonds - By enraging
the Roman against me.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p17">17. But the others out of love - To Christ and me. Knowing
- Not barely, supposing. That I am set - Literally, I lie; yet still
going forward in his work. He remained at Rome as an ambassador in a
place where he is employed on an important embassy.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p18">18. In pretense - Under colour of propagating the gospel.
In truth - With a real design so to do.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p19">19. This shall turn to my salvation - Shall procure me an
higher degree of glory. Through your prayer - Obtaining for me a larger
supply of the Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p20">20. As always - Since my call to the apostleship. In my
body - however it may be disposed of. How that might be, he did not yet
know. For the apostles did not know all things; particularly in things
pertaining to themselves, they had room to exercise faith and
patience.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p21">21. To me to live is Christ - To know, to love, to follow
Christ, is my life, my glory, my joy.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p22">22. Here he begins to treat of the former clause of the
preceding verse. Of the latter he treats, chap. ii, 17. But if I am to
live is the flesh, this is the fruit of my labour - This is the fruit of
my living longer, that I can labour more. Glorious labour! desirable
fruit! in this view, long life is indeed a blessing. And what I should
choose I know not - That is, if it were left to my choice.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p23">23. To depart - Out of bonds, flesh, the world. And to be
with Christ - In a nearer and fuller union. It is better to depart; it
is far better to be with Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p24">25. I know - By a prophetic notice given him while he was
writing this. That I shall continue some time longer with you - And
doubtless he did see them after this confinement.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p25">27. Only - Be careful for this, and nothing else. Stand
fast in one spirit - With the most perfect unanimity. Striving together
- With united strength and endeavours. For the faith of the gospel - For
all the blessings revealed and promised therein.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p26">28. Which - Namely, their being adversaries to the word of
God, and to you the messengers of God. Is an evident token - That they
are in the high road to perdition; and you, in the way of salvation.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p27">29. For to you it is given - As a special token of God's
love, and of your being in the way of salvation.</p>

<p id="i.xii.ii-p28">30. Having the same kind of conflict with your adversaries,
which ye saw in me - When I was with you, <scripRef passage="Acts xvi. 12, 19" id="i.xii.ii-p28.1" parsed="|Acts|16|12|0|0;|Acts|16|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.16.12 Bible:Acts.16.19">Acts xvi, 12, 19</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="19.76%" prev="i.xii.ii" next="i.xii.iv" id="i.xii.iii">
<h3 id="i.xii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Phil. II" id="i.xii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Phil|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.2" /> 

<p id="i.xii.iii-p1">1. If there be therefore any consolation - In the grace of
Christ. If any comfort - In the love of God. If any fellowship of the
Holy Ghost; if any bowels of mercies - Resulting therefrom; any tender
affection towards each other.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p2">2. Think the same thing - Seeing Christ is your common
Head. Having the same love - To God, your common Father. Being of one
soul - Animated with the same affections and tempers, as ye have all
drank ill to one spirit. Of one mind - Tenderly rejoicing and grieving
together.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p3">3. Do nothing through contention - Which is inconsistent
with your thinking the same thing. Or vainglory - Desire of praise,
which is directly opposite to the love of God. But esteem each the
others better than themselves - (For every one knows more evil of
himself than he can of another:) Which is a glorious fruit of the
Spirit, and an admirable help to your continuing "of one soul."</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p4">4. Aim not every one at his own things - Only. If so, ye
have not bowels of mercies.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p5">6. Who being in the essential form - The incommunicable
nature. Of God - From eternity, as he was afterward in the form of man;
real God, as real man. Counted it no act of robbery - That is the
precise meaning of the words, - no invasion of another's prerogative,
but his own strict and unquestionable right. To be equal with God - the
word here translated equal, occurs in the adjective form five or six
times in the New Testament, <scripRef passage="Matt. xx. 12" id="i.xii.iii-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|20|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.20.12">Matt. xx, 12</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke vi. 34" id="i.xii.iii-p5.2" parsed="|Luke|6|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.6.34">Luke vi,
34</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="John v. 18" id="i.xii.iii-p5.3" parsed="|John|5|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.5.18">John v, 18</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Acts xi. 17" id="i.xii.iii-p5.4" parsed="|Acts|11|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.11.17">Acts xi, 17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Rev. xxi. 16" id="i.xii.iii-p5.5" parsed="|Rev|21|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.21.16">Rev. xxi, 16</scripRef>. In all which places it expresses not a bare resemblance,
but a real and proper equalitg. It here implies both the fulness and the
supreme height of the Godhead; to which are opposed, he emptied and he
humbled himself.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p6">7. Yet - He was so far from tenaciously insisting upon,
that he willingly relinquished, his claim. He was content to forego the
glories of the Creator, and to appear in the form of a creature; nay, to
be made in the likeness of the fallen creatures; and not only to share
the disgrace, but to suffer the punishment, due to the meanest and
vilest among them all. He emptied himself - Of that divine fulness,
which he received again at his exaltation. Though he remained full, <scripRef passage="John i. 14" id="i.xii.iii-p6.1" parsed="|John|1|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.14">John i, 14</scripRef>, yet he appeared as if he had been empty; for he veiled his
fulness from the sight of men and angels. Yea, he not only veiled, but,
in some sense, renounced, the glory which he had before the world began.
Taking - And by that very act emptying himself. The form of a servant -
The form, the likeness, the fashion, though not exactly the same, are
yet nearly related to each other. The form expresses something absolute;
the likeness refers to other things of the same kind; the fashion
respects what appears to sight and sense. Being made in the likeness of
men - A real man, like other men. Hereby he took the form of a
servant.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p7">8. And being found in fashion as a man - A common man,
without any peculiar excellence or comeliness. He humbled himself - To a
still greater depth. Becoming obedient - To God, though equal with him.
Even unto death - The greatest instance both of humiliation and
obedience. Yea, the death of the cross - Inflicted on few but servants
or slaves.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p8">9. Wherefore - Because of his voluntary humiliation and
obedience. He humbled himself; but God hath exalted him - So
recompensing his humiliation. And hath given him - So recompensing his
emptying himself. A name which is above every name - Dignity and majesty
superior to every creature.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p9">10. That every knee - That divine honour might be paid in
every possible manner by every creature. Might bow - Either with love or
trembling. Of those in heaven, earth, under the earth - That is, through
the whole universe.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p10">11. And every tongue - Even of his enemies. Confess that
Jesus Christ is Lord - Jehovah; not now "in the form of a servant," but
enthroned in the glory of God the Father.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p11">12. Wherefore - Having proposed Christ's example, he
exhorts them to secure the salvation which Christ has purchased. As ye
have always - Hitherto. Obeyed - Both God, and me his minister. Now in
my absence - When ye have not me to instruct, assist, and direct you.
Work out your own salvation - Herein let every man aim at his own
things. With fear and trembling - With the utmost care and
diligence.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p12">13. For it is God - God alone, who is with you, though I am
not. That worketh in you according to his good pleasure - Not for any
merit of yours. Yet his influences are not to supersede, but to
encourage, our own efforts. Work out your own salvation - Here is our
duty. For it is God that worketh in you - Here is our encouragement. And
O, what a glorious encouragement, to have the arm of Omnipotence
stretched out for our support and our succor!</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p13">14. Do all things - Not only without contention, ver. 3,
but even without murmurings and disputings - Which are real, though
smaller, hindrances of love.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p14">15. That ye may be blameless - Before men. And simple -
Before God, aiming at him alone. As the sons of God - The God of love;
acting up to your high character. Unrebukable in the midst of a crooked
- Guileful, serpentine, and perverse generation - Such as the bulk of
mankind always were. Crooked - By a corrupt nature, and yet more
perverse by custom and practice.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p15">17. Here he begins to treat of the latter clause of chap.
i, 22. Yea, and if I be offered - Literally, If I be poured out. Upon
the sacrifice of your faith - The Philippians, as the other converted
heathens, were a sacrifice to God through St. Paul's ministry, <scripRef passage="Rom. xv. 16" id="i.xii.iii-p15.1" parsed="|Rom|15|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.15.16">Rom. xv, 16</scripRef>. And as in sacrificing, wine was poured at the foot of the
altar, so he was willing that his blood should be poured out. The
expression well agrees with that kind of martyrdom by which he was
afterwards offered up to God.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p16">18. Congratulate me - When I am offered up.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p17">19. When I know - Upon my return, that ye stand
steadfast.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p18">20. I have none - Of those who are now with me.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p19">21. For all - But Timotheus. Seek their own - Ease, safety,
pleasure, or profit. Amazing! In that golden age of the church, could
St. Paul throughly approve of one only, among all the labourers that
were with him? chap. i, 14, 17. And how many do we think can now approve
themselves to God? Not the things of Jesus Christ - They who seek these
alone, will sadly experience this. They will find few helpers likeminded
with themselves, willing naked to follow a naked Master.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p20">22. As a son with his father - He uses an elegant
peculiarity of phrase, speaking partly as of a son, partly as of a
fellowlabourer.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p21">25. To send Epaphroditus - Back immediately. Your messenger
- The Philippians had sent him to St. Paul with their liberal
contribution.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p22">26. He was full of heaviness - Because he supposed you
would be afflicted at hearing that he was sick.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p23">27. God had compassion on him - Restoring him to
health.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p24">28. That I may be the less sorrowful - When I know you are
rejoicing.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iii-p25">30. To supply your deficiency of service - To do what you
could not do in person.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="19.88%" prev="i.xii.iii" next="i.xii.v" id="i.xii.iv">
<h3 id="i.xii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Phil. III" id="i.xii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Phil|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.3" /> 

<p id="i.xii.iv-p1">1. The same things - Which you have heard before.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p2">2. Beware of dogs - Unclean, unholy, rapacious men. The
title which the Jews usually gave the gentiles, he returns upon
themselves. The concision - Circumcision being now ceased, the apostle
will not call them the circumcision, but coins a term on purpose, taken
from a Greek word used by the LXX, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxi. 5" id="i.xii.iv-p2.1" parsed="|Lev|21|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.21.5">Lev.
xxi, 5</scripRef>, for such a cutting as God had forbidden.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p3">3. For we - Christians. Are the only true circumcision -
The people now in covenant with God. Who worship God in spirit - Not
barely in the letter, but with the spiritual worship of inward holiness.
And glory in Christ Jesus - As the only cause of all our blessings. And
have no confidence in the flesh - In any outward advantage or
prerogative.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p4">4. Though I - He subjoins this in the singular number,
because the Philippians could not say thus.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p5">5. Circumcised the eighth day - Not at ripe age, as a
proselyte. Of the tribe of Benjamin - Sprung from the wife, not the
handmaid. An Hebrew of Hebrews - By both my parents; in everything,
nation, religion, language. Touching the law, a pharisee - One of that
sect who most accurately observe it.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p6">6. Having such a zeal for it as to persecute to the death
those who did not observe it. Touching the righteousness which is
described and enjoined by the Law - That is, external observances,
blameless.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p7">7. But all these things, which I then accounted gain, which
were once my confidence, my glory, and joy, those, ever since I have
believed, I have accounted loss, nothing worth in comparison of
Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p8">8. Yea, I still account both all these and all things else
to be mere loss, compared to the inward, experimental knowledge of
Christ, as my Lord, as my prophet, priest, and king, as teaching me
wisdom, atoning for my sins, and reigning in my heart. To refer this to
justification only, is miserably to pervert the whole scope of the
words. They manifestly relate to sanctification also; yea, to that
chiefly. For whom I have actually suffered the loss of all things -
Which the world loves, esteems, or admires; of which I am so far from
repenting, that I still account them but dung - The discourse rises.
Loss is sustained with patience, but dung is cast away with abhorrence.
The Greek word signifies any, the vilest refuse of things, the dross of
metals, the dregs of liquors, the excrements of animals, the most
worthless scraps of meat, the basest offals, fit only for dogs. That I
may gain Christ - He that loses all things, not excepting himself, gains
Christ, and is gained by Christ. And still there is more; which even St.
Paul speaks of his having not yet gained.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p9">9. And be found by God ingrafted in him, not having my own
righteousness, which is of the law - That merely outward righteousness
prescribed by the law, and performed by my own strength. But that inward
righteousness which is through faith - Which can flow from no other
fountain. The righteousness which is from God - From his almighty
Spirit, not by my own strength, but by faith alone. Here also the
apostle is far from speaking of justification only.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p10">10. The knowledge of Christ, mentioned in the eighth verse,
is here more largely explained. That I may know him - As my complete
saviour. And the power of his resurrection - Raising me from the death
of sin, into all the life of love. And the fellowship of his sufferings
- Being crucified with him. And made conformable to his death - So as to
be dead to all things here below.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p11">11. The resurrection of the dead - That is, the
resurrection to glory.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p12">12. Not that I have already attained - The prize. He here
enters on a new set of metaphors, taken from a race. But observe how, in
the utmost fervour, he retains his sobriety of spirit. Or am already
perfected - There is a difference between one that is perfect, and one
that is perfected. The one is fitted for the race, ver. 15; the other,
ready to receive the prize. But I pursue, if I may apprehend that -
Perfect holiness, preparatory to glory. For, in order to which I was
apprehended by Christ Jesus - Appearing to me in the way, <scripRef passage="Acts xxvi. 14" id="i.xii.iv-p12.1" parsed="|Acts|26|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.26.14">Acts xxvi, 14</scripRef>. The speaking conditionally both here and in the preceding
verse, implies no uncertainty, but only the difficulty of attaining.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p13">13. I do not account myself to have apprehended this
already; to be already possessed of perfect holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p14">14. Forgetting the things that are behind - Even that part
of the race which is already run. And reaching forth unto - Literally,
stretched out over the things that are before - Pursuing with the whole
bent and vigour of my soul, perfect holiness and eternal glory. In
Christ Jesus - The author and finisher of every good thing.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p15">15. Let us, as many as are perfect - Fit for the race,
strong in faith; so it means here. Be thus minded - Apply wholly to this
one thing. And if in anything ye - Who are not perfect, who are weak in
faith. Be otherwise minded - Pursuing other things. God, if ye desire
it, shall reveal even this unto you - Will convince you of it.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p16">16. But let us take care not to lose the ground we have
already gained. Let us walk by the same rule we have done hitherto.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p17">17. Mark them - For your imitation.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p18">18. Weeping - As he wrote. Enemies of the cross of Christ -
Such are all cowardly, all shamefaced, all delicate Christians.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p19">19. Whose end is destruction - This is placed in the front,
that what follows may be read with the greater horror. Whose God is
their belly - Whose supreme happiness lies in gratifying their sensual
appetites. Who mind - Relish, desire, seek, earthly things.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p20">20. Our conversation - The Greek word is of a very
extenslve meaning: our citizenship, our thoughts, our affections, are
already in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xii.iv-p21">21. Who will transform our vile body - Into the most
perfect state, and the most beauteous form. It will then be purer than
the unspotted firmament, brighter than the lustre of the stars and,
which exceeds all parallel, which comprehends all perfection, like unto
his glorious body - Like that wonderfully glorious body which he wears
in his heavenly kingdom, and on his triumphant throne.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="19.99%" prev="i.xii.iv" next="i.xiii" id="i.xii.v">
<h3 id="i.xii.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Phil. IV" id="i.xii.v-p0.2" parsed="|Phil|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.4" /> 

<p id="i.xii.v-p1">1. So stand - As ye have done hitherto.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p2">2. I beseech - He repeats this twice, as if speaking to
each face to face, and that with the utmost tenderness.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p3">3. And I entreat thee also, true yokefellow - St. Paul had
many fellowlabourers, but not many yokefellows. In this number was
Barnabas first, and then Silas, whom he probably addresses here; for
Silas had been his yokefellow at the very place, <scripRef passage="Acts xvi. 19" id="i.xii.v-p3.1" parsed="|Acts|16|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.16.19">Acts xvi, 19</scripRef>. Help those women who laboured together with me - Literally,
who wrestled. The Greek word doth not imply preaching, or anything of
that kind; but danger and toil endured for the sake of the gospel, which
was also endured at the same time, probably at Philippi, by Clement and
my other fellowlabourers - This is a different word from the former, and
does properly imply fellowpreachers. Whose names, although not set down
here, are in the book of life - As are those of all believers. An
allusion to the wrestlers in the Olympic games, whose names were all
enrolled in a book. Reader, is thy name there? Then walk circumspectly,
lest the Lord blot thee out of his book!</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p4">5. Let your gentleness - Yieldingness, sweetness of temper,
the result of joy in the Lord. Be known - By your whole behaviour. To
all men - Good and bad, gentle and froward. Those of the roughest
tempers are good natured to some, from natural sympathy and various
motives; a Christian, to all. The Lord - The judge, the rewarder, the
avenger. Is at hand - Standeth at the door.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p5">6. Be anxiously careful for nothing - If men are not gentle
towards you, yet neither on this, nor any other account, be careful, but
pray. Carefulness and prayer cannot stand together. In every thing -
Great and small. Let your requests be made known - They who by a
preposterous shame or distrustful modesty, cover, stifle, or keep in
their desires, as if they were either too small or too great, must be
racked with care; from which they are entirely delivered, who pour them
out with a free and filial confidence. To God - It is not always proper
to disclose them to men. By supplication - Which is the enlarging upon
and pressing our petition. With thanksgiving - The surest mark of a soul
free from care, and of prayer joined with true resignation. This is
always followed by peace. Peace and thanksgiving are both coupled
together, <scripRef passage="Colossians iii. 15" id="i.xii.v-p5.1" parsed="|Col|3|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.3.15">Colossians iii,
15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p6">7. And the peace of God - That calm, heavenly repose, that
tranquility of spirit, which God only can give. Which surpasseth all
understanding - Which none can comprehend, save he that receiveth it.
Shall keep - Shall guard, as a garrison does a city. Your hearts - Your
affections. Your minds - Your understandings, and all the various
workings of them; through the Spirit and power of Christ Jesus, in the
knowledge and love of God. Without a guard set on these likewise, the
purity and vigour of our affections cannot long be preserved.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p7">8. Finally - To sum up all. Whatsoever things are true -
Here are eight particulars placed in two fourfold rows; the former
containing their duty; the latter, the commendation of it. The first
word in the former row answers the first in the latter; the second word,
the second and so on. True - In speech. Honest - In action. Just - With
regard to others. Pure - With regard to yourselves. Lovely - And what
more lovely than truth? Of good report - As is honesty, even where it is
not practiced. If there be any virtue - And all virtues are contained in
justice. If there be any praise - In those things which relate rather to
ourselves than to our neighbour. Think on these things - That ye may
both practice them yourselves, and recommend them to others.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p8">9. The things which ye have learned - As catechumens. And
received - By continual instructions. And heard and seen - In my life
and conversation. These do, and the God of peace shall be with you - Not
only the peace of God, but God himself, the fountain of peace.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p9">10. I rejoiced greatly - St. Paul was no Stoic: he had
strong passions, but all devoted to God. That your care of me hath
flourished again - As a tree blossoms after the winter. Ye wanted
opportunity - Either ye had not plenty yourselves, or you wanted a
proper messenger.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p10">11. I have learned - From God. He only can teach this. In
everything, therewith to be content - Joyfully and thankfully patient.
Nothing less is Christian content. We may observe a beautiful gradation
in the expressions, I have learned; I know; I am instructed; I can.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p11">12. I know how to be abased - Having scarce what is needful
for my body. And to abound - Having wherewith to relieve others also.
Presently after, the order of the words is inverted, to intimate his
frequent transition from scarcity to plenty, and from plenty to
scarcity. I am instructed - Literally, I am initiated in that mystery,
unknown to all but Christians. Both to be full and to be hungry - For
one day. Both to abound and to want - For a longer season.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p12">13. I can do all things - Even fulfil all the will of
God.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p13">15. In the beginning of the gospel - When it was first
preached at Philippi. In respect of giving - On your part. And receiving
- On mine.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p14">17. Not that I desire - For my own sake, the very gift
which I receive of you.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p15">18. An odour of a sweet smell - More pleasing to God than
the sweetest perfumes to men.</p>

<p id="i.xii.v-p16">19. All your need - As ye have mine. According to his
riches in glory - In his abundant, eternal glory.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE COLOSSIANS" progress="20.08%" prev="i.xii.v" next="i.xiii.i" id="i.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Col" id="i.xiii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xiii-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO THE COLOSSIANS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Colossians" progress="20.08%" prev="i.xiii" next="i.xiii.ii" id="i.xiii.i">

<p id="i.xiii.i-p1">COLOSSE was a city of the Greater Phrygia, not far from
Laodicea and Hierapolis. Though St. Paul preached in many parts of
Phrygia, yet he never had been at this city. It had received the gospel
by the preaching of Epaphras, who was with St. Paul when he wrote this
epistle. It seems the Colossians were now in danger of being seduced by
those who strove to blend Judaism, or heathen superstitions, with
Christianity; pretending that God, because of his great majesty, was not
to be approached but by the mediation of angels; and that they were
certain rites and observances, chiefly borrowed from the law, whereby
these angels might be made our friends. In opposition to them, the
apostle,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.i-p2">1. Commends the knowledge of Christ, as more
excellent than all other, and so entire and perfect that no other
knowledge was necessary for a Christian. He shows,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.i-p3">2. That Christ is above all angels, who are
only his servants; and that, being reconciled to God through him, we
have free access to him in all our necessities. This epistle
contains,</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiii.i-p4">I. The inscription, Chap. i. 1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiii.i-p5">II. The doctrine, wherein the apostle
pathetically explains the mystery of Christ, By thanksgiving for the
Colossians, 3-8 By prayers for them, 9-23 With a declaration of his
affection for them, 24-29 ii. 1-3</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiii.i-p6">III. The exhortation,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xiii.i-p7">1. General, wherein he excites them to
perseverance, and warns them not to be deceived, 4-8 Describes again the
mystery of Christ in order, 9-15 And in the same order, draws his
admonitions,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.i-p8">1. From Christ the head, 16-19</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.i-p9">2. From his death, 20-23</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.i-p10">3. From his exaltation, iii. 1-4</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xiii.i-p11">2. Particular, 5-9</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.i-p12">1. To avoid several vices,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.i-p13">2. To practice several virtues, 10, 11
Especially to love one another, 12-15 And study the scriptures 16,
17</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.i-p14">3. To the relative duties of wives and
husbands,. 18, 19 Children and parents, 20, 21 Servants and masters,
22-25 iv.1 Final, to prayer, 2-4 to spiritual wisdom 5, 6</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiii.i-p15">V. The conclusion, 7-16</p>
<h2 id="i.xiii.i-p15.1">COLOSSIANS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="20.12%" prev="i.xiii.i" next="i.xiii.iii" id="i.xiii.ii">
<h3 id="i.xiii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Col. I" id="i.xiii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Col|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.1" /> 

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p1">2. The saints-This word expresses their union with God. And
brethren -- this, their union with their fellow-Christians.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p2">3. We give thanks - There is a near resemblance between
this epistle, and those to the Ephesians and Philippians.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p3">5. Ye heard before - I wrote to you. In the word of truth,
of the gospel - The true gospel preached to you.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p4">6. It bringeth forth fruit in all the world - That is, in
every place where it is preached. Ye knew the grace of God in truth -
Truly experienced the gracious power of God.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p5">7. The fellowservant - Of Paul and Timotheus.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p6">8. Your love in the Spirit - Your love wrought in you by
the Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p7">9. We pray for you - This was mentioned in general, <scripRef passage="Colossians i. 3" id="i.xiii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Col|1|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.1.3">Colossians i, 3</scripRef>, but now more particularly. That ye may be filled with the
knowledge of his will - Of his revealed will. In all wisdom - With all
the wisdom from above. And spiritual understanding - To discern by that
light whatever agrees with, or differs from, his will.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p8">10. That, knowing his whole will, ye may walk worthy of the
Lord, unto all pleasing - So as actually to please him in all things;
daily increasing in the living, experimental knowledge of God, our
Father, saviour, Sanctifier.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p9">11. Strengthened unto all patience and longsuffering with
joyfulness - This is the highest point: not only to know, to do, to
suffer, the whole will of God; but to suffer it to the end, not barely
with patience, but with thankful joy.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p10">12. Who, by justifying and sanctifying us, hath made us
meet for glory.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p11">13. Power detains reluctant captives, a kingdom cherishes
willing subjects. His beloved Son - This is treated of in the fifteenth
and following verses.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p12">14. In whom we have redemption - This is treated of from
the middle of <scripRef passage="Colossians i. 18" id="i.xiii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Col|1|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.1.18">Colossians i,
18</scripRef>. The voluntary passion of our Lord appeased the Father's
wrath, obtained pardon and acceptance for us, and, consequently,
dissolved the dominion and power which Satan had over us through our
sins. So that forgiveness is the beginning of redemption, as the
resurrection is the completion of it.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p13">15. Who is - By describing the glory of Christ, and his
preeminence over the highest angels, the apostle here lays a
foundation for the reproof of all worshippers of angels. The image of
the invisible God - Whom none can represent, but his only begotten Son;
in his divine nature the invisible image, in his human the visible
image, of the Father. The first begotten of every creature - That is,
begotten before every creature; subsisting before all worlds, before all
time, from all eternity.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p14">16. For - This explains the latter part of the preceding
verse. Through implies something prior to the particles by and for; so
denoting the beginning, the progress, and the end. Him - This word,
frequently repeated, signifies his supreme majesty, and excludes every
creature. Were created all things that are in heaven - And heaven
itself. But the inhabitants are named, because more noble than the
house. Invisible - The several species of which are subjoined. Thrones
are superior to dominions; principalities, to powers. Perhaps the two
latter may express their office with regard to other creatures: the two
former may refer to God, who maketh them his chariots, and, as it were,
rideth upon their wings.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p15">17. And he is before all things - It is not said, he was:
he is from everlasting to everlasting. And by him all things consist -
The original expression not only implies, that he sustains all things in
being, but more directly, All things were and are compacted in him into
one system. He is the cement, as well as support, of the universe. And
is he less than the supreme God?</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p16">18. And - From the whole he now descends to the most
eminent part, the church. He is the head of the church - Universal; the
supreme and only head both of influence and of government to the whole
body of believers. Who is - The repetition of the expression { <scripRef passage="Colossians i. 15" id="i.xiii.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Col|1|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.1.15">Colossians i, 15</scripRef>} points out the entrance on a new paragraph. The beginning -
Absolutely, the Eternal. The first begotten from the dead - From whose
resurrection flows all the life, spiritual and eternal, of all his
brethren. That in all things - Whether of nature or grace. He might have
the preeminence - Who can sound this depth?</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p17">19. For it pleased the Father that all fulness - All the
fulness of God. Should dwell in him - Constantly, as in a temple; and
always ready for our approach to him.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p18">20. Through the blood of the cross - The blood shed
thereon. Whether things on earth - Here the enmity began: therefore this
is mentioned first. Or things in heaven - Those who are now in paradise;
the saints who died before Christ came.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p19">21. And you that were alienated, and enemies - Actual
alienation of affection makes habitual enmity. In your mind - Both your
understanding and your affections. By wicked works - Which continually
feed and increase inward alienation from, and enmity to, God. He hath
now reconciled - From the moment ye believed.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p20">22. By the body of his flesh - So distinguished from his
body, the church. The body here denotes his entire manhood. Through
death - Whereby he purchased the reconciliation which we receive by
faith. To present you - The very end of that reconciliation. Holy -
Toward God. Spotless - In yourselves. Unreprovable - As to your
neighbour.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p21">23. If ye continue in the faith - Otherwise, ye will lose
all the blessings which ye have already begun to enjoy. And be not
removed from the hope of the gospel - The glorious hope of perfect love.
Which is preached - Is already begun to be preached to every creature
under heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p22">24. Now I rejoice in my sufferings for you, and fill up -
That is, whereby I fill up. That which is behind of the sufferings of
Christ - That which remains to be suffered by his members. These are
termed the sufferings of Christ,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.ii-p23">1. Because the suffering of any member is the
suffering of the whole; and of the head especially, which supplies
strength, spirits, sense, and motion to all.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.ii-p24">2. Because they are for his sake, for the
testimony of his truth. And these also are necessary for the church; not
to reconcile it to God, or satisfy for sin, (for that Christ did
perfectly,) but for example to others, perfecting of the saints, and
increasing their reward.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p25">25. According to the dispensation of God which is given me
- Or, the stewardship with which I am intrusted.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p26">26. The mystery - Namely, Christ both justifying and
sanctifying gentiles, as well as Jews. Which hath been comparatively hid
from former ages and past generations of men.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p27">27. Christ dwelling and reigning in you, The hope of glory
- The ground of your hope.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.ii-p28">28. We teach the ignorant, and admonish them that are
already taught.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="20.23%" prev="i.xiii.ii" next="i.xiii.iv" id="i.xiii.iii">
<h3 id="i.xiii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Col. II" id="i.xiii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Col|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.2" /> 

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p1">1. How great a conflict - Of care, desire, prayer. As many
as have not seen my face - Therefore, in writing to the Colossians, he
refrains from those familiar appellations, "Brethren," "Beloved."</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p2">2. Unto all riches of the full assurance of understanding,
unto the acknowledgment of the mystery of God - That is, unto the
fullest and clearest understanding and knowledge of the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p3">6. So walk in him - In the same faith, love, holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p4">7. Rooted in him - As the vine. Built - On the sure
foundation.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p5">8. Through philosophy and empty deceit - That is, through
the empty deceit of philosophy blended with Christianity. This the
apostle condemns,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.iii-p6">1. Because it was empty and deceitful,
promising happiness, but giving none.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.iii-p7">2. Because it was grounded, not on solid
reason, but the traditions of men, Zeno, Epicurus, and the rest.
And,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiii.iii-p8">3. Because it was so shallow and superficial,
not advancing beyond the knowledge of sensible things; no, not beyond
the first rudiments of them.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p9">9. For in him dwelleth - Inhabiteth, continually abideth,
all the fulness of the Godhead. Believers are "filled with all the
fulness of God," <scripRef passage="Eph. iii. 19" id="i.xiii.iii-p9.1" parsed="|Eph|3|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.3.19">Eph. iii,
19</scripRef>. But in Christ dwelleth all the fulness of the Godhead; the
most full Godhead; not only divine powers, but divine nature, <scripRef passage="Colossians i. 19" id="i.xiii.iii-p9.2" parsed="|Col|1|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.1.19">Colossians i, 19</scripRef>. Bodily - Personally, really, substantially. The very
substance of God, if one might so speak, dwells in Christ in the most
full sense.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p10">10. And ye - Who believe. Are filled with him - <scripRef passage="John i. 16" id="i.xiii.iii-p10.1" parsed="|John|1|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.16">John i, 16</scripRef>. Christ is filled with God, and ye are filled with Christ.
And ye are filled by him. The fulness of Christ overflows his church, <scripRef passage="Psalm cxxxiii. 3" id="i.xiii.iii-p10.2" parsed="|Ps|133|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.133.3">Psalm cxxxiii, 3</scripRef>. He is originally full. We are filled by him with wisdom and
holiness. Who is the head of all principality and power - Of angels as
well as men Not from angels therefore, but from their head, are we to
ask whatever we stand in need of.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p11">11. By whom also ye have been circumcised - Ye have
received the spiritual blessings typified of old by circumcision. With a
circumcision not performed with hands - By an inward, spiritual
operation. In putting off, not a little skin, but the whole body of the
sins of the flesh - All the sins of your evil nature. By the
circumcision of Christ - By that spiritual circumcision which Christ
works in your heart.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p12">12. Which he wrought in you, when ye were as it were buried
with him in baptism - The ancient manner of baptizing by immersion is as
manifestly alluded to here, as the other manner of baptizing by
sprinkling or pouring of water is, <scripRef passage="Heb. x. 22" id="i.xiii.iii-p12.1" parsed="|Heb|10|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.10.22">Heb.
x, 22</scripRef>. But no stress is laid on the age of the baptized, or the
manner of performing it, in one or the other; but only on our being
risen with Christ, through the powerful operation of God in the soul;
which we cannot but know assuredly, if it really is so: and if we do not
experience this, our baptism has not answered the end of its
institution. By which ye are also risen with him - From the death of sin
to the life of holiness. It does not appear, that in all this St. Paul
speaks of justification at all, but of sanctification altogether.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p13">13. And you who were dead - Doubly dead to God, not only
wallowing in trespasses, outward sins, but also in the uncircumcision of
your flesh - A beautiful expression for original sin, the inbred
corruption of your nature, your uncircumcised heart and affections. Hath
he - God the Father. Quickened together with him - Making you partakers
of the power of his resurrection. It is evident the apostle thus far
speaks, not of justification, but of sanctification only.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p14">14. Having blotted out - in consequence of his gracious
decrees, that Christ should come into the world to save sinners, and
that whosoever believeth on him should have everlasting life. The
handwriting against us - Where a debt is contracted, it is usually
testified by some handwriting; and when the debt is forgiven, the
handwriting is destroyed, either by blotting it out, by taking it away,
or by tearing it. The apostle expresses in all these three ways, God's
destroying the handwriting which was contrary to us, or at enmity with
us. This was not properly our sins themselves, (they were the debt,) but
their guilt and cry before God.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p15">15. And having spoiled the principalities and powers - The
evil angels, of their usurped dominion. He - God the Father. Exposed
them openly - Before all the hosts of hell and heaven. Triumphing over
them in or by him - By Christ. Thus the paragraph begins with Christ,
goes on with him, and ends with him.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p16">16. Therefore - Seeing these things are so. Let none judge
you - That is, regard none who judge you. In meat or drink - For not
observing the ceremonial law in these or any other particulars. Or in
respect of a yearly feast, the new moon, or the weekly Jewish
sabbaths.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p17">17. Which are but a lifeless shadow; but the body, the
substance, is of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p18">18. Out of pretended humility, they worshipped angels, as
not daring to apply immediately to God. Yet this really sprung from
their being puffed up: (the constant forerunner of a fall, (<scripRef passage="Prov. xvi. 18" id="i.xiii.iii-p18.1" parsed="|Prov|16|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.16.18">Prov. xvi, 18</scripRef>) so far was it from being an instance of true humility.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p19">19. And not holding the head - He does not hold Christ, who
does not trust in him alone. All the members are nourished by faith, and
knit together by love and mutual sympathy.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p20">20. Therefore - The inference begun, <scripRef passage="Colossians ii. 16" id="i.xiii.iii-p20.1" parsed="|Col|2|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.2.16">Colossians ii, 16</scripRef>; is continued. A new inference follows, <scripRef passage="Colossians iii. 1" id="i.xiii.iii-p20.2" parsed="|Col|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.3.1">Colossians iii, 1</scripRef>. If ye are dead with Christ from the rudiments of the world
- That is, If ye are dead with Christ, and so freed from them, why
receive ye ordinances - Which Christ hath not enjoined, from which he
hath made you free.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p21">21. Touch not - An unclean thing. Taste not - Any forbidden
meat. Handle not - Any consecrated vessel.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p22">22. Perish in the using - Have no farther use, no influence
on the mind.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iii-p23">23. Not sparing the body - Denying it many gratifications,
and putting it to many inconveniences. Yet they are not of any real
value before God, nor do they, upon the whole, mortify, but satisfy, the
flesh. They indulge our corrupt nature, our self-will, pride, and desire
of being distinguished from others.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="20.34%" prev="i.xiii.iii" next="i.xiii.v" id="i.xiii.iv">
<h3 id="i.xiii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Col. III" id="i.xiii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Col|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.3" /> 

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p1">1. If ye are risen, seek the things above - As Christ being
risen, immediately went to heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p2">3. For ye are dead - To the things on earth. And your real,
spiritual life is hid from the world, and laid up in God, with Christ -
Who hath merited, promised, prepared it for us, and gives us the earnest
and foretaste of it in our hearts.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p3">4. When Christ - The abruptness of the sentence surrounds
us with sudden light. Our life - The fountain of holiness and glory.
Shall appear - In the clouds of heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p4">5. Mortify therefore - Put to death, slay with a continued
stroke. Your members - Which together make up the body of sin. Which are
upon the earth - Where they find their nourishment. Uncleanness - In
act, word, or thought. Inordinate affection - Every passion which does
not flow from and lead to the love of God. Evil desire - The desire of
the flesh, the desire of the eye, and the pride of life. Covetousness -
According to the derivation of the word, means the desire of having
more, or of any thing independent on God. Which is idolatry - Properly
and directly; for it is giving the heart to a creature.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p5">6. For which - Though the heathens lightly regarded
them.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p6">7. Living denotes the inward principle; walking, the
outward acts.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p7">8. Wrath - Is lasting anger. Filthy discourse - And was
there need to warn even these saints of God against so gross and
palpable a sin as this? O what is man, till perfect love casts out both
fear and sin.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p8">10. In knowledge - The knowledge of God, his will, his
word.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p9">11. Where - In which case, it matters not what a man is
externally, whether Jew or gentile, circumcised, or uncircumcised,
barbarian, void of all the advantages of education, yea, Scythian, of
all barbarians most barbarous. But Christ is in all that are thus
renewed, and is all things in them and to them.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p10">12. All who are thus renewed are elected of God, holy, and
therefore the more beloved of him. Holiness is the consequence of their
election, and God's superior love, of their holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p11">13. Forbearing one another - If anything is now wrong. And
forgiving one another - What is past.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p12">14. The love of God contains the whole of Christian
perfection, and connects all the parts of it together.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p13">15. And then the peace of God shall rule in your hearts -
Shall sway every temper, affection, thought, as the reward (so the Greek
word implies) of your preceding love and obedience.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p14">16. Let the word of Christ - So the apostle calls the whole
scripture, and thereby asserts the divinity of his Master. Dwell - Not
make a short stay, or an occasional visit, but take up its stated
residence. Richly - In the largest measure, and with the greatest
efficacy; so as to fill and govern the whole soul.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p15">17. In the name - In the power and Spirit of the Lord
Jesus. Giving thanks unto God - The Holy Ghost. And the Father through
him - Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p16">18. Wives, submit - Or be subject to. It is properly a
military term, alluding to that entire submission that soldiers pay to
their general. <scripRef passage="Eph. v. 22" id="i.xiii.iv-p16.1" parsed="|Eph|5|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.5.22">Eph. v, 22</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p17">19. Be not bitter - (Which may be without any appearance of
anger) either in word or spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p18">21. Lest they be discouraged - Which may occasion their
turning either desperate or stupid.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p19">22. Eyeservice - Being more diligent under their eye than
at other times. Singleness of heart - A simple intention of doing right,
without looking any further. Fearing God - That is, acting from this
principle.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.iv-p20">23. Heartily - Cheerfully, diligently. Menpleasers are soon
dejected and made angry: the single-hearted are never displeased or
disappointed; because they have another aim, which the good or evil
treatment of those they serve cannot disappoint.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="20.41%" prev="i.xiii.iv" next="i.xiv" id="i.xiii.v">
<h3 id="i.xiii.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Col. IV" id="i.xiii.v-p0.2" parsed="|Col|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.4" /> 

<p id="i.xiii.v-p1">1. Just - According to your contract. Equitable - Even
beyond the letter of your contract.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.v-p2">3. That God would open to us a door of utterance - That is,
give us utterance, that we "may open our mouth boldly," <scripRef passage="Eph. vi. 19" id="i.xiii.v-p2.1" parsed="|Eph|6|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.6.19">Eph. vi, 19</scripRef>, and give us an opportunity of speaking, so that none may be
able to hinder.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.v-p3">6. Let your speech be always with grace - Seasoned with the
grace of God, as flesh is with salt.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.v-p4">10. Aristarchus my fellowprisoner - Such was Epaphras
likewise for a time, <scripRef passage="Phil. i. 23" id="i.xiii.v-p4.1" parsed="|Phil|1|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.1.23">Phil. i,
23</scripRef>. Ye have received directions - Namely, by Tychicus, bringing
this letter. The ancients adapted their language to the time of reading
the letter; not, as we do, to the time when it was written. It is not
improbable, they might have scrupled to receive him, without this fresh
direction, after he had left St. Paul, and "departed from the work."</p>

<p id="i.xiii.v-p5">11. These - Three, Aristarchus, Marcus, and Justus. Of all
the circumcision - That is, of all my Jewish fellowlabourers. Are the
only fellowworkers unto the kingdom of God - That is, in preaching the
gospel. Who have been a comfort to me - What, then, can we expect? that
all our fellowworkers should be a comfort to us?</p>

<p id="i.xiii.v-p6">12. Perfect - Endued with every Christian grace. Filled -
As no longer being babes, but grown up to the measure of the stature of
Christ; being full of his light, grace, wisdom, holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.v-p7">14. Luke, the physician - Such he had been, at least, if he
was not then.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.v-p8">15. Nymphas - Probably an eminent Christian at
Laodicea.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.v-p9">16. The epistle from Laodicea - Not to Laodicea. Perhaps
some letter had been written to St. Paul from thence.</p>

<p id="i.xiii.v-p10">17. And say to Archippus - One of the pastors of that
church. Take heed - It is the duty of the flock to try them that say
they are apostles to reject the false, and to warn, as well as to
receive, the real. The ministry - Not a lordship, but a service; a
labourious and painful work; an obligation to do and suffer all things;
to be the least, and the servant, of all. In the Lord - Christ by whom,
and for whose sake, we receive the various gifts of the Holy Spirit.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S FIRST EPISTLE TO THE THESSALONIANS" progress="20.44%" prev="i.xiii.v" next="i.xiv.i" id="i.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1Thess" id="i.xiv-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xiv-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S FIRST EPISTLE TO THE THESSALONIANS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to First Thessalonians" progress="20.44%" prev="i.xiv" next="i.xiv.ii" id="i.xiv.i">

<p id="i.xiv.i-p1">THIS is the first of all the epistles which St. Paul wrote.
Thessalonica was one of the chief cities of Macedonia. Hither St. Paul
went after the persecution at Philippi: but he had not preached here
long before the unbelieving Jews raised a tumult against him and
Silvanus and Timotheus. On this the brethren sent them away to Berea.
Thence St. Paul went by sea to Athens, and sent for Silvanus and
Timotheus to come speedily to him. But being in fear, lest the
Thessalonian converts should be moved from their steadfastness, after a
short time he sends Timotheus to them, to know the state of their
church. Timotheus returning found the apostle at Corinth from whence he
sent them this epistle, about a year after he had been at Thessalonica.
The parts of it are these:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiv.i-p2">I. The inscription, Chap. i, 1</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiv.i-p3">II. He celebrates the grace of God towards
them,. 2-10 Mentions the sincerity of himself and his fellowlabourers,
ii. 1-12 And the teachableness of the Thessalonians,. 13-16</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiv.i-p4">III. He declares,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xiv.i-p5">1. His desire, 17-20</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xiv.i-p6">2. His care, iii. 1-5</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xiv.i-p7">3. His joy and prayer for them, 6-13</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiv.i-p8">IV. He exhorts them to grow,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xiv.i-p9">1. In holiness, iv.1-8</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xiv.i-p10">2. In brotherly love with industry, 9-12</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiv.i-p11">V. He teaches and exhorts,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xiv.i-p12">1. Concerning them that sleep, 13-18</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xiv.i-p13">2. Concerning the times, v.1-11</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiv.i-p14">VI. He adds miscellaneous exhortations,
12-24</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xiv.i-p15">VII. The conclusion, 25-28</p>
<h2 id="i.xiv.i-p15.1">1 THESSALONIANS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="20.47%" prev="i.xiv.i" next="i.xiv.iii" id="i.xiv.ii">
<h3 id="i.xiv.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Thess. I" id="i.xiv.ii-p0.2" parsed="|1Thess|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.1" /> 

<p id="i.xiv.ii-p1">1. Paul - In this epistle St. Paul neither uses the title
of an apostle, nor any other, as writing to pious and simple-hearted
men, with the utmost familiarity. There is a peculiar sweetness in this
epistle, unmixed with any sharpness or reproof: those evils which the
apostles afterward reproved having not yet crept into the church.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.ii-p2">3. Remembering in the sight of God - That is, praising him
for it. Your work of faith - Your active, ever-working faith. And labour
of love - Love continually labouring for the bodies or souls of men.
They who do not thus labour, do not love. Faith works, love labours,
hope patiently suffers all things.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.ii-p3">4. Knowing your election - Which is through faith, by these
plain proofs.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.ii-p4">5. With power - Piercing the very heart with a sense of sin
and deeply convincing you of your want of a saviour from guilt, misery,
and eternal ruin. With the Holy Ghost - Bearing an outward testimony, by
miracles, to the truth of what we preached, and you felt: also by his
descent through laying on of hands. With much assurance - Literally,
with full assurance, and much of it: the Spirit bearing witness by
shedding the love of God abroad in your hearts, which is the highest
testimony that can be given. And these signs, if not the miraculous
gifts, always attend the preaching of the gospel, unless it be in vain:
neither are the extraordinary operations of the Holy Ghost ever wholly
withheld, where the gospel is preached with power, and men are alive to
God. For your sake - Seeking your advantage, not our own.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.ii-p5">6. Though in much affliction, yet with much joy.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.ii-p6">8. For from you the word sounded forth - (Thessalonica
being a city of great commerce.) Being echoed, as it were, from you. And
your conversion was divulged far beyond Macedonia and Achaia. So that we
need not speak anything - Concerning it.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.ii-p7">9. For they themselves - The people wherever we come.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.ii-p8">10. Whom he hath raised from the dead - In proof of his
future coming to judgment. Who delivereth us - He redeemed us once; he
delivers us continually; and will deliver all that believe from the
wrath, the eternal vengeance, which will then come upon the ungodly.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="20.51%" prev="i.xiv.ii" next="i.xiv.iv" id="i.xiv.iii">
<h3 id="i.xiv.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Thess. II" id="i.xiv.iii-p0.2" parsed="|1Thess|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.2" /> 

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p1">1. What was proposed, chap. i, 5, 6, is now more largely
treated of: concerning Paul and his fellowlabourers, ver. 1-12;
concerning the Thessalonians, ver. 13-16.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p2">2. We had suffered - In several places. We are bold -
Notwithstanding. With much contention - Notwithstanding both inward and
outward conflicts of all kinds.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p3">3. For our exhortation - That is, our preaching. A part is
put for the whole. Is not, at any time, of deceit - We preach not a lie,
but the truth of God. Nor of uncleanness - With any unholy or selfish
view. This expression is not always appropriated to lust, although it is
sometimes emphatically applied thereto. Nor in guile - But with great
plainness of speech.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p4">5. Flattering words - This ye know. Nor a cloak of
covetousness - Of this God is witness. He calls men to witness an open
fact; God, the secret intentions of the heart. In a point of a mixed
nature, ver. 10, he appeals both to God and man.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p5">6. Nor from others - Who would have honoured us more, if we
had been burdensome - That is, taken state upon ourselves.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p6">7. But we were gentle - Mild, tender. In the midst of you -
Like a hen surrounded with her young. Even as a nurse cherisheth her own
children - The offspring of her own womb.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p7">8. To impart our own souls - To lay down our lives for your
sake.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p8">10. Holily - In the things of God. Justly - With regard to
men. Unblamable - In respect of ourselves. Among you that believe - Who
were the constant observers of our behaviour.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p9">11. By exhorting, we are moved to do a thing willingly; by
comforting, to do it joyfully; by charging, to do it carefully.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p10">12. To his kingdom here, and glory hereafter.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p11">14. Ye suffered the same things - The same fruit, the same
afflictions, and the same experience, at all times, and in all places,
are an excellent criterion of evangelical truth. As they from the Jews -
Their countrymen.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p12">15. Us - Apostles and preachers of the gospel. They please
not God - Nor are they even careful to please him, notwithstanding their
fair professions. And are contrary to all men - Are common enemies of
mankind; not only by their continual seditions and insurrections, and by
their utter contempt of all other nations; but in particular, by their
endeavouring to hinder their hearing or receiving the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p13">16. To fill up - The measure of their sins always, as they
have ever done. But the vengeance of God is come upon them - Hath
overtaken them unawares, whilst they were seeking to destroy others, and
will speedily complete their destruction.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p14">17. In this verse we have a remarkable instance, not so
much of the transient affections of holy grief, desire, or joy, as of
that abiding tenderness, that loving temper, which is so apparent in all
St. Paul's writings, towards those he styles his children in the faith.
This is the more carefully to be observed, because the passions
occasionally exercising themselves, and flowing like a torrent, in the
apostle, are observable to every reader; whereas it requires a nicer
attention to discern those calm standing tempers, that fixed posture of
his soul, from whence the others only flow out, and which more
peculiarly distinguish his character.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p15">18. Satan - By those persecuting Jews, <scripRef passage="Acts xvii. 13" id="i.xiv.iii-p15.1" parsed="|Acts|17|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.17.13">Acts xvii, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iii-p16">19. Ye also - As well as our other children.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="20.56%" prev="i.xiv.iii" next="i.xiv.v" id="i.xiv.iv">
<h3 id="i.xiv.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Thess. III" id="i.xiv.iv-p0.2" parsed="|1Thess|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.3" /> 

<p id="i.xiv.iv-p1">1. We - Paul and Silvanus. Could bear no longer - Our
desire and fear for you.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iv-p2">3. We are appointed hereto - Are in every respect laid in a
fit posture for it, by the very design and contrivance of God himself
for the trial and increase of our faith and all other graces. He gives
riches to the world; but stores up his treasure of wholesome afflictions
for his children.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iv-p3">6. But now when Timotheus was come to us from you -
Immediately after his return, St. Paul wrote; while his joy was fresh,
and his tenderness at the height.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iv-p4">8. Now we live - Indeed; we enjoy life: so great is our
affection for you.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iv-p5">10. And perfect that which is wanting in your faith - So
St. Paul did not know that "they who are once upon the rock no longer
need to be taught by man."</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iv-p6">11. Direct our way - This prayer is addressed to Christ, as
well as to the Father.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.iv-p7">13. With all his, Christ's, saints - Both angels and
men.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="20.58%" prev="i.xiv.iv" next="i.xiv.vi" id="i.xiv.v">
<h3 id="i.xiv.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Thess. IV" id="i.xiv.v-p0.2" parsed="|1Thess|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.4" /> 

<p id="i.xiv.v-p1">1. More and more - It is not enough to have faith, even so
as to please God, unless we abound more and more therein.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p2">3. Sanctification - Entire holiness of heart and life:
particular branches of it are subjoined. That ye abstain from
fornication - A beautiful transition from sanctification to a single
branch of the contrary; and this shows that nothing is so seemingly
distant, or below our thoughts, but we have need to guard against
it.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p3">4. That every one know - For this requires knowledge, as
well as chastity. To possess his vessel - His wife. In sanctification
and honour - So as neither to dishonour God or himself, nor to obstruct,
but further, holiness; remembering, marriage is not designed to inflame,
but to conquer, natural desires.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p4">5. Not in passionate desire - Which had no place in man
when in a state of innocence. Who know not God - And so may naturally
seek happiness in a creature. What seemingly accidental words slide in;
and yet how fine, and how vastly important!</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p5">6. In this matter - By violating his bed. The things
forbidden, here are three: fornication, ver. 3; the passion of desire,
or inordinate affection in the married state, ver. 5; and the breach of
the marriage contract.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p6">8. He that despiseth - The commandments we gave. Despiseth
God - Himself. Who hath also given you his Holy Spirit - To convince you
of the truth, and enable you to be holy. What naked majesty of words!
How oratorical, and yet with what great simplicity!-a simplicity that
does not impair, but improve, the understanding to the utmost; that,
like the rays of heat through a glass, collects all the powers of reason
into one orderly point, from being scattered abroad in utter
confusion.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p7">9. We need not write - Largely. For ye are taught of God -
By his Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p8">11. That ye study - Literally, that ye be ambitious: an
ambition worthy a Christian. To work with your hands - Not a needless
caution; for temporal concerns are often a cross to them who are newly
filled with the love of God.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p9">12. Decently - That they may have no pretense to say, (but
they will say it still,) "This religion makes men idle, and brings them
to beggary." And may want nothing - Needful for life and godliness. What
Christian desires more?</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p10">13. Now - Herein the efficacy of Christianity greatly
appears, - that it neither takes away nor embitters, but sweetly
tempers, that most refined of all affections, our desire of or love to
the dead.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p11">14. So - As God raised him. With him - With their living
head.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p12">15. By the word of the Lord - By a particular Revelation.
We who are left - This intimates the fewness of those who will be then
alive, compared to the multitude of the dead. Believers of all ages and
nations make up, as it were, one body; in consideration of which, the
believers of that age might put themselves in the place, and speak in
the person, of them who were to live till the coming of the Lord. Not
that St. Paul hereby asserted (though some seem to have imagined so)
that the day of the Lord was at hand.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p13">16. With a shout - Properly, a proclamation made to a great
multitude. Above this is, the voice of the archangel; above both, the
trumpet of God; the voice of God, somewhat analogous to the sound of a
trumpet.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.v-p14">17. Together - In the same moment. In the air - The wicked
will remain beneath, while the righteous, being absolved, shall be
assessors with their Lord in the judgment. With the Lord - In
heaven.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="20.64%" prev="i.xiv.v" next="i.xv" id="i.xiv.vi">
<h3 id="i.xiv.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Thess. V" id="i.xiv.vi-p0.2" parsed="|1Thess|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.5" /> 

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p1">1. But of the precise times when this shall be.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p2">2. For this in general ye do know; and ye can and need know
no more.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p3">3. When they - The men of the world say.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p4">4. Ye are not in darkness - Sleeping secure in sin.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p5">6. Awake, and keep awake - Being awakened, let us have all
our spiritual senses about us.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p6">7. They usually sleep and are drunken in the night - These
things do not love the light.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p7">9. God hath not appointed us to wrath - As he hath the
obstinately impenitent.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p8">10. Whether we wake or sleep - Be alive or dead at his
coming.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p9">12. Know them that,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiv.vi-p10">1. labour among you:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiv.vi-p11">2. Are over you in the Lord:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiv.vi-p12">3. Admonish you. Know - See, mark, take
knowledge of them and their work. Sometimes the same person may both
labour, that is, preach; be over, or govern; and admonish the flock by
particular application to each: sometimes two or more different persons,
according as God variously dispenses his gifts. But O, what a misery is
it when a man undertakes this whole work without either gifts or graces
for any part of it! Why, then, will he undertake it? for pay? What! will
he sell both his own soul and all the souls of the flock? What words can
describe such a wretch as this? And yet even this may be "an honourable
man!"</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p13">13. Esteem them very highly - Literally, more than
abundantly, in love - The inexpressible sympathy that is between true
pastors and their flock is intimated, not only here, but also in divers
other places of this epistle. See</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xiv.vi-p14">chap. ii, 7, 8. For their work's sake - The
principal ground of their vast regard for them. But how are we to esteem
them who do not work at all?</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p15">14. Warn the disorderly - Them that stand, as it were, out
of their rank in the spiritual warfare. Some such were even in that
church. The feeble-minded - Literally, them of little soul; such as have
no spiritual courage.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p16">15. See that none - Watch over both yourselves and each
other. Follow that which is good - Do it resolutely and
perseveringly.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p17">16. Rejoice evermore - In uninterrupted happiness in God.
Pray without ceasing - Which is the fruit of always rejoicing in the
Lord. In everything give thanks - Which is the fruit of both the former.
This is Christian perfection. Further than this we cannot go; and we
need not stop short of it. Our Lord has purchased joy, as well as
righteousness, for us. It is the very design of the gospel that, being
saved from guilt, we should be happy in the love of Christ. Prayer may
be said to be the breath of our spiritual life. He that lives cannot
possibly cease breathing. So much as we really enjoy of the presence of
God, so much prayer and praise do we offer up without ceasing; else our
rejoicing is but delusion. Thanksgiving is inseparable from true prayer:
it is almost essentially connected with it. He that always prays is ever
giving praise, whether in ease or pain, both for prosperity and for the
greatest adversity. He blesses God for all things, looks on them as
coming from him, and receives them only for his sake; not choosing nor
refusing, liking nor disliking, anything, but only as it is agreeable or
disagreeable to his perfect will.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p18">18. For this - That you should thus rejoice, pray, give
thanks. Is the will of God - Always good, always pointing at our
salvation.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p19">19. Quench not the Spirit - Wherever it is, it burns; it
flames in holy love, in joy, prayer, thanksgiving. O quench it not, damp
it not in yourself or others, either by neglecting to do good, or by
doing evil!</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p20">20. Despise not prophesyings - That is, preaching; for the
apostle is not here speaking of extraordinary gifts. It seems, one means
of grace is put for all; and whoever despises any of these, under
whatever pretense, will surely (though perhaps gradually and almost
insensibly) quench the Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p21">21. Meantime, prove all things - Which any preacher
recommends. (He speaks of practice, not of doctrines.) Try every advice
by the touchstone of scripture, and hold fast that which is good -
Zealously, resolutely, diligently practice it, in spite of all
opposition.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p22">22. And be equally zealous and careful to abstain from all
appearance of evil - Observe, those who "heap to themselves teachers,
having itching ears," under pretense of proving all things, have no
countenance or excuse from this scripture.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p23">23. And may the God of peace sanctify you - By the peace he
works in you, which is a great means of sanctification. Wholly - The
word signifies wholly and perfectly; every part and all that concerns
you; all that is of or about you. And may the whole of you, the spirit
and the soul and the body - Just before he said you; now he denominates
them from their spiritual state. The spirit - <scripRef passage="Gal. vi. 8" id="i.xiv.vi-p23.1" parsed="|Gal|6|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.6.8">Gal. vi, 8</scripRef>; wishing that it may be preserved whole and entire: then
from their natural state, the soul and the body; (for these two make up
the whole nature of man, <scripRef passage="Matt. x. 28" id="i.xiv.vi-p23.2" parsed="|Matt|10|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.10.28">Matt. x, 28</scripRef>;) wishing it may be preserved blameless till the coming of
Christ. To explain this a little further: of the three here mentioned,
only the two last are the natural constituent parts of man. The first is
adventitious, and the supernatural gift of God, to be found in
Christians only. That man cannot possibly consist of three parts,
appears hence: The soul is either matter or not matter: there is no
medium. But if it is matter, it is part of the body: if not matter, it
coincides with the Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p24">24. Who also will do it - Unless you quench the Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xiv.vi-p25">27. I charge you by the Lord - Christ, to whom proper
divine worship is here paid. That this epistle - The first he wrote. Be
read to all the brethren -- that is, in all the churches. They might have
concealed it out of modesty, had not this been so solemnly enjoined: but
what Paul commands under so strong an adjuration, Rome forbids under
pain of excommunication.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S SECOND EPISTLE TO THE THESSALONIANS" progress="20.74%" prev="i.xiv.vi" next="i.xv.i" id="i.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2Thess" id="i.xv-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xv-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S SECOND EPISTLE TO THE THESSALONIANS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Second Thessalonians" progress="20.74%" prev="i.xv" next="i.xv.ii" id="i.xv.i">

<p id="i.xv.i-p1">THIS epistle seems to have been written soon after the
former, chiefly on occasion of some things therein which had been
misunderstood. Herein he,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xv.i-p2">1. Congratulates their constancy in the
faith, and exhorts them to advance daily in grace and wisdom.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xv.i-p3">2. Reforms their mistake concerning the
coming of our Lord And,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xv.i-p4">3. Recommends several Christian duties. The
parts of it are five:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xv.i-p5">I. The inscription, Chap. i. 1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xv.i-p6">II. Thanksgiving and prayer for them,
3-12</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xv.i-p7">III. The doctrine concerning the man of sin,.
ii. 1-12 Whence he comforts them against this trial, 13, 14 Adding
exhortation and prayer, 15-17</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xv.i-p8">IV. An exhortation to prayer, with a prayer
for. iii. 1-5 them, to correct the disorderly, 6-16</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xv.i-p9">V. The conclusion, 17, 18</p>
<h2 id="i.xv.i-p9.1">2nd THESSALONIANS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="20.76%" prev="i.xv.i" next="i.xv.iii" id="i.xv.ii">
<h3 id="i.xv.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Thess. I" id="i.xv.ii-p0.2" parsed="|2Thess|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Thess.1" /> 

<p id="i.xv.ii-p1">3. It is highly observable, that the apostle wraps up his
praise of men in praise to God; giving him the glory. Your faith groweth
- Probably he had heard from them since his sending the former letter.
Aboundeth - Like water that overflows its banks, and yet increaseth
still.</p>

<p id="i.xv.ii-p2">4. Which ye endure - "That ye may be accounted worthy of
the kingdom."</p>

<p id="i.xv.ii-p3">5. A manifest token - This is treated of in the sixth and
following verses.</p>

<p id="i.xv.ii-p4">6. It is a righteous thing with God - (However men may
judge) to transfer the pressure from you to them. And it is remarkable
that about this time, at the passover, the Jews raising a tumult, a
great number (some say thirty thousand) of them were slain. St. Paul
seems to allude to this beginning of sorrows, <scripRef passage="1 Thess. ii. 16" id="i.xv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Thess|2|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.2.16">1 Thess. ii, 16</scripRef>, which did not end but with their destruction.</p>

<p id="i.xv.ii-p5">8. Taking vengeance - Does God barely permit this, or (as
"the Lord" once "rained brimstone and fire from the Lord out of heaven,"
<scripRef passage="Gen. xix. 24" id="i.xv.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|19|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.19.24">Gen. xix, 24</scripRef>) does a fiery stream go forth from him forever? Who know
not God - (The root of all wickedness and misery) who remain in heathen
ignorance. And who obey not - This refers chiefly to the Jews, who had
heard the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.xv.ii-p6">9. From the glory of his power - Tremble, ye stout-hearted.
Everlasting destruction - As there can be no end of their sins, (the
same enmity against God continuing,) so neither of their punishment; sin
and its punishment running parallel throughout eternity itself. They
must of necessity, therefore, be cut off from all good, and all
possibility of it. From the presence of the Lord - Wherein chiefly
consists the salvation of the righteous. What unspeakable punishment is
implied even in falling short of this, supposing that nothing more were
implied in his taking vengeance!</p>

<p id="i.xv.ii-p7">10. To be glorified in his saints - For the wonderful glory
of Christ shall shine in them.</p>

<p id="i.xv.ii-p8">11. All the good pleasure of his goodness - Which is no
less than perfect holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xv.ii-p9">12. That the name - The love and power of our Lord may be
glorified - Gloriously displayed in you.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="20.79%" prev="i.xv.ii" next="i.xv.iv" id="i.xv.iii">
<h3 id="i.xv.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Thess. II" id="i.xv.iii-p0.2" parsed="|2Thess|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Thess.2" /> 

<p id="i.xv.iii-p1">1. Our gathering together to him - In the clouds.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p2">2. Be not shaken in mind - In judgment. Or terrified - As
those easily are who are immoderately fond of knowing future things.
Neither by any pretended Revelation from the Spirit, nor by pretense of
any word spoken by me.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p3">3. Unless the falling away - From the pure faith of the
gospel, come first. This began even in the apostolic age. But the man of
sin, the son of perdition - Eminently so called, is not come yet.
However, in many respects, the Pope has an indisputable claim to those
titles. He is, in an emphatical sense, the man of sin, as he increases
all manner of sin above measure. And he is, too, properly styled, the
son of perdition, as he has caused the death of numberless multitudes,
both of his opposers and followers, destroyed innumerable souls, and
will himself perish everlastingly. He it is that opposeth himself to the
emperor, once his rightful sovereign; and that exalteth himself above
all that is called God, or that is worshipped - Commanding angels, and
putting kings under his feet, both of whom are called gods in scripture;
claiming the highest power, the highest honour; suffering himself, not
once only, to be styled God or vice-God. Indeed no less is implied in
his ordinary title, "Most Holy Lord," or, "Most Holy Father." So that he
sitteth - Enthroned. In the temple of God - Mentioned <scripRef passage="Rev. xi. 1" id="i.xv.iii-p3.1" parsed="|Rev|11|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.11.1">Rev. xi, 1</scripRef>. Declaring himself that he is God - Claiming the
prerogatives which belong to God alone.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p4">6. And now ye know - By what I told you when I was with
you. That which restraineth - The power of the Roman emperors. When this
is taken away, the wicked one will be revealed. In his time - His
appointed season, and not before.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p5">7. He will surely be revealed; for the mystery - The deep,
secret power of iniquity, just opposite to the power of godliness,
already worketh. It began with the love of honour, and the desire of
power; and is completed in the entire subversion of the gospel of
Christ. This mystery of iniquity is not wholly confined to the Romish
church, but extends itself to others also. It seems to consist of,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xv.iii-p6">1. Human inventions added to the written
word.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xv.iii-p7">2. Mere outside performances put in the room
of faith and love.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xv.iii-p8">3. Other mediators besides the man Christ
Jesus. The two last branches, together with idolatry and bloodshed, are
the direct consequences of the former; namely, the adding to the word of
God. Already worketh - In the church. Only he that restraineth - That
is, the potentate who successively has Rome in his power. The emperors,
heathen or Christian; the kings, Goths or Lombards; the Carolingian or
German emperors.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p9">8. And then - When every prince and power that restrains is
taken away. Will that wicked one - Emphatically so called, be revealed.
Whom the Lord will soon consume with the spirit of his mouth - His
immediate power. And destroy - With the very first appearance of his
glory.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p10">10. Because they received not the love of the truth -
Therefore God suffered them to fall into that "strong delusion."</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p11">11. Therefore God shall send them - That is, judicially
permit to come upon them, strong delusion.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p12">12. That they all may be condemned - That is, the
consequence of which will be, that they all will be condemned who
believed not the truth, but had pleasure in unrighteousness - That is,
who believed not the truth, because they loved sin.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p13">13. God hath from the beginning - Of your hearing the
gospel. Chosen you to salvation - Taken you out of the world, and placed
you in the way to glory.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p14">14. To which - Faith and holiness. He hath called you by
our gospel - That which we preached, accompanied with the power of his
Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iii-p15">15. Hold - Without adding to, or diminishing from, the
traditions which ye have been taught - The truths which I have delivered
to you. Whether by word or by our epistle - He preached before he wrote.
And he had written concerning this in his former epistle.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="20.86%" prev="i.xv.iii" next="i.xvi" id="i.xv.iv">
<h3 id="i.xv.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Thess. III" id="i.xv.iv-p0.2" parsed="|2Thess|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Thess.3" /> 

<p id="i.xv.iv-p1">1. May run - Go on swiftly, without any interruption. And
be glorified - Acknowledged as divine, and bring forth much fruit.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p2">2. All men have not faith - And all men who have not are
more or less unreasonable and wicked men.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p3">3. Who will stablish you - That cleave to him by faith. And
guard you from the evil one - And all his instruments.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p4">4. We trust in the Lord concerning you - Thus only should
we trust in any man.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p5">5. Now the Lord - The Spirit, whose proper work this is.
Direct - Lead you straight forward. Into the patience of Christ - Of
which he set you a pattern.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p6">6. That walketh disorderly - Particularly by not working.
Not according to the tradition he received of us - The admonition we
gave, both by word of mouth, and in our former epistle.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p7">10. Neither let him eat - Do not maintain him in
idleness.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p8">11. Doing nothing, but being busybodies - To which idleness
naturally disposes.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p9">12. Work quietly - Letting the concerns of other people
alone.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p10">14. Have no company with him - No intimacy, no familiarity,
no needless correspondence.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p11">15. Admonish him as a brother - Tell him lovingly of the
reason why you shun him.</p>

<p id="i.xv.iv-p12">16. The Lord of peace - Christ. Give you peace by all means
- In every way and manner.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S FIRST EPISTLE TO TIMOTHY" progress="20.88%" prev="i.xv.iv" next="i.xvi.i" id="i.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1Tim" id="i.xvi-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xvi-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S FIRST EPISTLE TO TIMOTHY</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to First Timothy" progress="20.88%" prev="i.xvi" next="i.xvi.ii" id="i.xvi.i">

<p id="i.xvi.i-p1">THE mother of Timothy was a Jewess, but his father was a
gentile. He was converted to Christianity very early; and while he was
yet but a youth, was taken by St. Paul to assist him in the work of the
gospel, chiefly in watering the churches which he had planted. He was
therefore properly, as was Titus, an itinerant evangelist, a kind of
secondary apostle, whose office was, to regulate all things in the
churches to which he was sent; and to inspect and reform whatsoever was
amiss either in the bishops, deacons, or people. St. Paul had doubtless
largely instructed him in private conversation for the due execution of
so weighty an office. Yet to fix things more upon his mind, and to give
him an opportunity of having recourse to them afterward, and of
communicating them to others, as there might be occasion, as also to
leave divine directions in writing, for the use of the church and its
ministers in all ages; he sent him this excellent pastoral letter, which
contains a great variety of important sentiments for their regulation.
Though St. Paul styles him his "own son in the faith," yet he does not
appear to have been converted by the apostle; but only to have been
exceeding dear to him, who had established him therein; and whom he had
diligently and faithfully served, like a son with his father in the
gospel. <scripRef passage="Phil. ii. 22" id="i.xvi.i-p1.1" parsed="|Phil|2|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.2.22">Phil. ii, 22</scripRef>. The epistle contains three parts:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xvi.i-p2">I. The inscription, C.i.1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xvi.i-p3">II. The instruction of Timothy how to behave
at Ephesus, wherein,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xvi.i-p4">1. In general, he gives him an injunction to
deliver to them that taught the law in a wrong manner, and confirms at
the same time the sum of the gospel as exemplified in himself, 3-20</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xvi.i-p5">2. In particular,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvi.i-p6">1. He prescribes to men, a method of prayer,.
C.ii.1-8 To women, good works and modesty, 9-15</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvi.i-p7">2. He recounts the requisites of a bishop,.
C.iii.1-7 The duties of deacons, 8-10 of women, 11-13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvi.i-p8">3. He shows what Timothy should teach
14-C.iv.1-6 What he should avoid, 7-11 What follow after, 12-16 How he
should treat men and women, C.v.1, 2 Widows, 3-16 Elders, 17-19
Offenders, 20, 21 Himself, 22, 23 Those he doubts of, 24, 25 Servants,
C.vi.1, 2</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvi.i-p9">4. False teachers are reproved, 3-10 Timothy
is admonished, quickened, 11, 12 and charged, 13-16 Precepts are
prescribed to be enforced on the rich, 17-19</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xvi.i-p10">III. The conclusion, 20,</p>
<h2 id="i.xvi.i-p10.1">1st TIMOTHY</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="20.92%" prev="i.xvi.i" next="i.xvi.iii" id="i.xvi.ii">
<h3 id="i.xvi.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Tim. I" id="i.xvi.ii-p0.2" parsed="|1Tim|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.1" /> 

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p1">1. Paul an apostle - Familiarity is to be set aside 
where the
things of God are concerned. According to the commandment of God - The
authoritative appointment of God the Father. Our saviour - So styled in
many other places likewise, as being the grand orderer of the whole
scheme of our salvation. And Christ our hope - That is, the author,
object, and ground, of all our hope.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p2">2. Grace, mercy, peace - St. Paul wishes grace and peace in
his epistles to the churches. To Timotheus he adds mercy, the most
tender grace towards those who stand in need of it. The experience of
this prepares a man to be a minister of the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p3">3. Charge some to teach no other doctrine - Than I have
taught. Let them put nothing in the place of it, add nothing to it.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p4">4. Neither give heed - So as either to teach or regard
them. To fables - Fabulous Jewish traditions. And endless genealogies -
Nor those delivered in scripture, but the long intricate pedigrees
whereby they strove to prove their descent from such or such a person.
Which afford questions - Which lead only to useless and endless
controversies.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p5">5. Whereas the end of the commandment - of the whole
Christian institution. Is love - And this was particularly the end of
the commandment which Timotheus was to enforce at Ephesus, ver. 3, 18.
The foundation is faith; the end, love. But this can only subsist in an
heart purified by faith, and is always attended with a good
conscience.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p6">6. From which - Love and a good conscience. Some are turned
aside - An affectation of high and extensive knowledge sets a man at the
greatest distance from faith, and all sense of divine things. To vain
jangling - And of all vanities, none are more vain than dry, empty
disputes on the things of God.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p7">7. Understanding neither the very things they speak, nor
the subject they speak of.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p8">8. We grant the whole Mosaic law is good, answers excellent
purposes, if a man use it in a proper manner. Even the ceremonial is
good, as it points to Christ; and the moral law is holy, just, and good,
on its own nature; and of admirable use both to convince unbelievers,
and to guide believers in all holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p9">9. The law doth not lie against a righteous man - Doth not
strike or condemn him. But against the lawless and disobedient - They
who despise the authority of the lawgiver violate the first commandment,
which is the foundation of the law, and the ground of all obedience.
Against the ungodly and sinners - Who break the second commandment,
worshipping idols, or not worshipping the true God. The unholy and
profane - Who break the third commandment by taking his name in
vain.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p10">10. Manstealers - The worst of all thieves, in comparison
of whom, highwaymen and housebreakers are innocent. What then are most
traders in negroes, procurers of servants for America, and all who list
soldiers by lies, tricks, or enticements?</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p11">11. According to the glorious gospel - Which, far from
"making void," does effectually "establish, the law."</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p12">12. I thank Christ, who hath enabled me, in that he
accounted me faithful, having put me into the ministry - The meaning is,
I thank him for putting me into the ministry, and enabling me to be
faithful therein.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p13">13. A blasphemer - Of Christ. A persecutor - Of his church.
A reviler - Of his doctrine and people. But I obtained mercy - He does
not say, because I was unconditionally elected; but because I did it in
ignorance. Not that his ignorance took away his sin; but it left him
capable of mercy; which he would hardly have been, had he acted thus
contrary to his own conviction.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p14">14. And the grace - Whereby I obtained mercy. Was exceeding
abundant with faith - Opposite to my preceding unbelief. And love -
Opposite to my blasphemy, persecution, and oppression.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p15">15. This is a faithful saying - A most solemn preface. And
worthy of all acceptation - Well deserving to be accepted, received,
embraced, with all the faculties of our whole soul. That Christ -
Promised. Jesus - Exhibited. Came into the world to save sinners - All
sinners, without exception.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p16">16. For this cause God showed me mercy, that all his
longsuffering might be shown, and that none might hereafter despair.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p17">17. The King of eternity - A phrase frequent with the
Hebrews. How unspeakably sweet is the thought of eternity to
believers!</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p18">18. This charge I commit to thee - That thou mayest deliver
it to the church. According to the prophecies concerning thee - Uttered
when thou wast received as an evangelist, chap. iv, 14; probably by many
persons, chap. vi, 12; that, being encouraged by them, thou mightest war
the good warfare.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p19">19. Holding fast faith - Which is as a most precious
liquor. And a good conscience - Which is as a clean glass. Which -
Namely, a good conscience. Some having thrust away - It goes away
unwillingly it always says, "Do not hurt me." And they who retain this
do not make shipwreck of their faith. Indeed, none can make shipwreck of
faith who never had it. These, therefore, were once true believers: yet
they fell not only foully, but finally; for ships once wrecked cannot be
afterwards saved.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.ii-p20">20. Whom - Though absent. I have delivered to Satan, that
they may learn not to blaspheme - That by what they suffer they may be
in some measure restrained, if they will not repent.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="21.02%" prev="i.xvi.ii" next="i.xvi.iv" id="i.xvi.iii">
<h3 id="i.xvi.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Tim. II" id="i.xvi.iii-p0.2" parsed="|1Tim|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.2" /> 

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p1">1. I exhort therefore - Seeing God is so gracious. In this
chapter he gives directions,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvi.iii-p2">1. With regard to public prayers</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvi.iii-p3">2. With regard to doctrine. Supplication is
here the imploring help in time of need: prayer is any kind of offering
up our desires to God. But true prayer is the vehemency of holy zeal,
the ardour of divine love, arising from a calm, undisturbed soul, moved
upon by the Spirit of God. Intercession is prayer for others. We may
likewise give thanks for all men, in the full sense of the word, for
that God "willeth all men to be saved," and Christ is the Mediator of
all.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p4">2. For all that are in authority - Seeing even the lowest
country magistrates frequently do much good or much harm. God supports
the power of magistracy for the sake of his own people, when, in the
present state of men, it could not otherwise be kept up in any nation
whatever. Godliness - Inward religion; the true worship of God. Honesty
- A comprehensive word taking in the whole duty we owe to our
neighbour.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p5">3. For this - That we pray for all men. Do you ask, "Why
are not more converted?" We do not pray enough. Is acceptable in the
sight of God our saviour - Who has actually saved us that believe, and
willeth all men to be saved. It is strange that any whom he has actually
saved should doubt the universality of his grace!</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p6">4. Who willeth seriously all men - Not a part only, much
less the smallest part. To be saved - Eternally. This is treated of,
ver. 5, 6. And, in order thereto, to come - They are not compelled. To
the knowledge of the truth - Which brings salvation. This is treated of,
ver. 6, 7.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p7">5. For - The fourth verse is proved by the fifth; the
first, by the fourth. There is one God - And they who have not him,
through the one Mediator, have no God. One mediator also - We could not
rejoice that there is a God, were there not a mediator also; one who
stands between God and men, to reconcile man to God, and to transact the
whole affair of our salvation. This excludes all other mediators, as
saints and angels, whom the Papists set up and idolatrously worship as
such: just as the heathens of old set up many mediators, to pacify their
superior gods. The man - Therefore all men are to apply to this
mediator, "who gave himself for all."</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p8">6. Who gave himself a ransom for all - Such a ransom, the
word signifies, wherein a like or equal is given; as an eye for an eye,
or life for life: and this ransom, from the dignity of the person
redeeming, was more than equivalent to all mankind. To be testified of
in due season - Literally, in his own seasons; those chosen by his own
wisdom.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p9">8. I will - A word strongly expressing his apostolical
authority. Therefore - This particle connects the eighth with the first
verse. That men pray in every place - Public and private. Wherever men
are, there prayer should be. Lifting up holy hands - Pure from all known
sin. Without wrath - In any kind, against any creature. And every temper
or motion of our soul that is not according to love is wrath. And
doubting - Which is contrary to faith. And wrath, or unholy actions, or
want of faith in him we call upon, are the three grand hindrances of
God's hearing our petitions. Christianity consists of faith and love,
embracing truth and grace: therefore the sum of our wishes should be, to
pray, and live, and die, without any wrath or doubt.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p10">9. With sobriety - Which, in St. Paul's sense, is the
virtue which governs our whole life according to true wisdom. Not with
curled hair, not with gold - Worn by way of ornament. Not with pearls -
Jewels of any kind: a part is put for the whole. Not with costly raiment
- These four are expressly forbidden by name to all women (here is no
exception) professing godliness, and no art of man can reconcile with
the Christian profession the wilful violation of an express command.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p11">12. To usurp authority over the man - By public
teaching.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p12">13. First - So that woman was originally the inferior.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p13">14. And Adam was not deceived - The serpent deceived Eve:
Eve did not deceive Adam, but persuaded him. "Thou hast hearkened unto
the voice of thy wife," <scripRef passage="Gen. iii. 17" id="i.xvi.iii-p13.1" parsed="|Gen|3|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.3.17">Gen. iii,
17</scripRef>. The preceding verse showed why a woman should not "usurp
authority over the man." this shows why she ought not "to teach." She is
more easily deceived, and more easily deceives. The woman being deceived
transgressed - "The serpent deceived" her, <scripRef passage="Gen. iii. 13" id="i.xvi.iii-p13.2" parsed="|Gen|3|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.3.13">Gen. iii, 13</scripRef>, and she transgressed.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iii-p14">15. Yet she - That is, women in general, who were all
involved with Eve in the sentence pronounced, <scripRef passage="Gen. iii. 16" id="i.xvi.iii-p14.1" parsed="|Gen|3|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.3.16">Gen. iii, 16</scripRef>. Shall be saved in childbearing - Carried safe through the
pain and danger which that sentence entails upon them for the
transgression; yea, and finally saved, if they continue in loving faith
and holy wisdom.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="21.10%" prev="i.xvi.iii" next="i.xvi.v" id="i.xvi.iv">
<h3 id="i.xvi.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Tim. III" id="i.xvi.iv-p0.2" parsed="|1Tim|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.3" /> 

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p1">1. He desireth a good work - An excellent, but labourious,
employment.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p2">2. Therefore - That he may be capable of it. A bishop - Or
pastor of a congregation. Must be blameless - Without fault or just
suspicion. The husband of one wife - This neither means that a bishop
must be married, nor that he may not marry a second wife; which it is
just as lawful for him to do as to marry a first, and may in some cases
be his bounden duty. But whereas polygamy and divorce on slight
occasions were common both among the Jews and heathens, it teaches us
that ministers, of all others, ought to stand clear of those sins.
Vigilant, prudent - Lively and zealous, yet calm and wise. Of good
behaviour - Naturally flowing from that vigilance and prudence.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p3">4. Having his children in subjection with all seriousness -
For levity undermines all domestic authority; and this direction, by a
parity of reason, belongs to all parents.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p4">6. Lest being puffed up - With this new honour, or with the
applause which frequently follows it. He fall into the condemnation of
the devil - The same into which the devil fell.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p5">7. He ought also to have a good report - To have had a fair
character in time past. From them that are without - That are not
Christians. Lest he fall into reproach - By their rehearsing his former
life, which might discourage and prove a snare to him.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p6">8. Likewise the deacons must be serious - Men of a grave,
decent, venerable behaviour. But where are presbyters? Were this order
essentially distinct from that of bishops, could the apostle have passed
it over in silence? Not desirous of filthy gain - With what abhorrence
does he everywhere speak of this! All that is gained (above food and
raiment) by ministering in holy things is filthy gain indeed; far more
filthy than what is honestly gained by raking kennels, or emptying
common sewers.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p7">9. Holding fast the faith in a pure conscience - Steadfast
in faith, holy in heart and life.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p8">10. Let these be proved first - Let a trial be made how
they believe. Then let them minister - Let them be fixed in that
office.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p9">11. Faithful in all things - Both to God, their husbands,
and the poor.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p10">13. They purchase a good degree - Or step, toward some
higher office. And much boldness - From the testimony of a good
conscience.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p11">15. That thou mayest know how to behave - This is the scope
of the epistle. In the house of God - Who is the master of the family.
Which is - As if he had said, By the house of God, I mean the
church.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.iv-p12">16. The mystery of godliness - Afterwards specified in six
articles, which sum up the whole economy of Christ upon earth. Is the
pillar and ground - The foundation and support of all the truth taught
in his church. God was manifest in the flesh - In the form of a servant,
the fashion of a man, for three and thirty years. Justified by the
Spirit - Publicly "declared to be the Son of God," by his resurrection
from the dead. Seen - Chiefly after his resurrection. By angels - Both
good and bad. Preached among the gentiles - This elegantly follows. The
angels were the least, the gentiles the farthest, removed from him; and
the foundation both of this preaching and of their faith was laid before
his assumption. Was believed on in the world - Opposed to heaven, into
which he was taken up. The first point is, He was manifested in the
flesh; the last, He was taken up into glory.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="21.16%" prev="i.xvi.iv" next="i.xvi.vi" id="i.xvi.v">
<h3 id="i.xvi.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Tim. IV" id="i.xvi.v-p0.2" parsed="|1Tim|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.4" /> 

<p id="i.xvi.v-p1">1. But the Spirit saith - By St. Paul himself to the
Thessalonians, and probably by other contemporary prophets. Expressly -
As concerning a thing of great moment, and soon to be fulfilled. That in
the latter times - These extend from our Lord's ascension till his
coming to judgment. Some - Yea, many, and by degrees the far greater
part. Will depart from the faith - The doctrine once delivered to the
saints. Giving heed to seducing spirits - Who inspire false
prophets.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p2">2. These will depart from the faith, by the hypocrisy of
them that speak lies, having their own consciences as senseless and
unfeeling as flesh that is seared with an hot iron.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p3">3. Forbidding priests, monks, and nuns to marry, and
commanding all men to abstain from such and such meats at such and such
times. Which God hath created to be received by them that know the truth
- That all meats are now clean. With thanksgiving - Which supposes a
pure conscience.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p4">5. It is sanctified by the word of God - Creating all, and
giving it to man for food. And by prayer - The children of God are to
pray for the sanctification of all the creatures which they use. And not
only the Christians, but even the Jews, yea, the very heathens used to
consecrate their table by prayer.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p5">7. Like those who were to contend in the Grecian games,
exercise thyself unto godliness - Train thyself up in holiness of heart
and life, with the utmost labour, vigour, and diligence.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p6">8. Bodily exercise profiteth a little - Increases the
health and strength of the body.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p7">10. Therefore - Animated by this promise. We both labour
and suffer reproach - We regard neither pleasure, ease, nor honour.
Because we trust - For this very thing the world will hate us. In the
living God - Who will give us the life he has promised. Who is the
saviour of all men - Preserving them in this life, and willing to save
them eternally. But especially - In a more eminent manner. Of them that
believe - And so are saved everlastingly.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p8">12. Let no one have reason to despise thee for thy youth.
To prevent this, Be a pattern in word - Public and private. In spirit -
In your whole temper. In faith - When this is placed in the midst of
several other Christian graces, it generally means a particular branch
of it; fidelity or faithfulness.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p9">13. Give thyself to reading - Both publicly and privately.
Enthusiasts, observe this! Expect no end without the means.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p10">14. Neglect not - They neglect it who do not exercise it to
the full. The gift - Of feeding the flock, of power, and love, and
sobriety. Which was given thee by prophecy - By immediate direction from
God. By the laying on of my hands - <scripRef passage="2 Tim. i. 6" id="i.xvi.v-p10.1" parsed="|2Tim|1|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.1.6">2
Tim. i, 6</scripRef>; while the elders joined also in the solemnity. This
presbytery probably consisted of some others, together with Paul and
Silas.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p11">15. Meditate - The Bible makes no distinction between this
and to contemplate, whatever others do. True meditation is no other than
faith, hope, love, joy, melted down together, as it were, by the fire of
God's Holy Spirit; and offered up to God in secret. He that is wholly in
these, will be little in worldly company, in other studies, in
collecting books, medals, or butterflies: wherein many pastors drone
away so considerable a part of their lives.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.v-p12">16. Continue in them - In all the preceding advices.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="21.22%" prev="i.xvi.v" next="i.xvi.vii" id="i.xvi.vi">
<h3 id="i.xvi.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Tim. V" id="i.xvi.vi-p0.2" parsed="|1Tim|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.5" /> 

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p1">1. Rebuke not - Considering your own youth, with such a
severity as would otherwise be proper.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p2">3. honour - That is, maintain out of the public stock.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p3">4. Let these learn to requite their parents - For all their
former care, trouble, and expense.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p4">5. Widows indeed - Who have no near relations to provide
for them; and who are wholly devoted to God. Desolate - Having neither
children, nor grandchildren to relieve her.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p5">6. She that liveth in pleasure - Delicately, voluptuously,
in elegant, regular sensuality, though not in the use of any such
pleasures as are unlawful in themselves.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p6">7. That they - That is, the widows.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p7">8. If any provide not - Food and raiment. For his own -
Mother and grandmother, being desolate widows. He hath - Virtually.
Denied the faith - Which does not destroy, but perfect, natural duties.
What has this to do with heaping up money for our children, for which it
is often so impertinently alleged? But all men have their reasons for
laying up money. One will go to hell for fear of want; another acts like
a heathen, lest he should be worse than an infidel.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p8">9. Let not a widow be chosen - Into the number of
deaconesses, who attended sick women or travelling preachers. Under
threescore - Afterwards they were admitted at forty, if they were
eminent for holiness. Having been the wife of one husband - That is,
having lived in lawful marriage, whether with one or more persons
successively.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p9">10. If she hath washed the feet of the saints - Has been
ready to do the meanest offices for them.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p10">11. Refuse - Do not choose. For when they are waxed wanton
against Christ - To whose more immediate service they had addicted
themselves. They want to marry - And not with a single eye to the glory
of God; and so withdraw themselves from that entire service of the
church to which they were before engaged.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p11">12. They have rejected their first faith - Have deserted
their trust in God, and have acted contrary to the first conviction,
namely, that wholly to devote themselves to his service was the most
excellent way. When we first receive power to believe, does not the
Spirit of God generally point out what are the most excellent things;
and at the same time, give us an holy resolution to walk in the highest
degree of Christian severity? And how unwise are we ever to sink into
anything below it!</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p12">14. I counsel therefore the younger women - Widows or
virgins, such as are not disposed to live single. To marry, to bear
children, to guide the family - Then will they have sufficient
employment of their own. And give no occasion of reproach to the
adversary - Whether Jew or heathen.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p13">15. Some - Widows. Have turned aside after Satan - Who has
drawn them from Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p14">17. Let the elders that rule well - Who approve themselves
faithful stewards of all that is committed to their charge. Be counted
worthy of double honour - A more abundant provision, seeing that such
will employ it all to the glory of God. As it was the most labourious
and disinterested men who were put into these offices, so whatever any
one had to bestow, in his life or death, was generally lodged in their
hands for the poor. By this means the churchmen became very rich in
after ages, but as the design of the donors was something else, there is
the highest reason why it should be disposed of according to their pious
intent. Especially those - Of them. Who labour - Diligently and
painfully. In the word and teaching - In teaching the word.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p15">18. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 4" id="i.xvi.vi-p15.1" parsed="|Deut|25|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.4">Deut. xxv,
4</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p16">19. Against an elder - Or presbyter. Do not even receive an
accusation, unless by two or three witnesses - By the Mosaic law, a
private person might be cited (though not condemned) on the testimony of
one witness; but St. Paul forbids an elder to be even cited on such
evidence, his reputation being of more importance than that of
others.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p17">20. Those - Elders. That sin - Scandalously, and are duly
convicted. Rebuke before all - The church.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p18">21. I charge thee before God - Referring to the last
judgment, in which we shall stand before God and Christ, with his elect,
that is, holy, angels, who are the witnesses of our conversation. The
apostle looks through his own labours, and even through time itself, and
seems to stand as one already in eternity. That thou observe these
things without prejudging - Passing no sentence till the cause is fully
heard. Or partiality - For or against any one.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p19">22. Lay hands suddenly on no man - That is, appoint no man
to church offices without full trial and examination; else thou wilt be
accessary to, and accountable for, his misbehaviour in his office. Keep
thy self pure - From the blood of all men.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p20">24. Some men's sins are manifest beforehand - Before any
strict inquiry be made. Going before to judgment - So that you may
immediately judge them unworthy of any spiritual office. And some they -
Their sins. Follow after - More covertly.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vi-p21">25. They that are otherwise - Not so manifest. Cannot be
long hid - From thy knowledge. On this account, also, be not hasty in
laying on of hands.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="21.31%" prev="i.xvi.vi" next="i.xvii" id="i.xvi.vii">
<h3 id="i.xvi.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Tim. VI" id="i.xvi.vii-p0.2" parsed="|1Tim|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.6" /> 

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p1">1. Let servants under the yoke - Of heathen masters.
Account them worthy of all honour - All the honour due from a servant to
a master. Lest the name of God and his doctrine be blasphemed - As it
surely will, if they do otherwise.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p2">2. Let them not despise them - Pay them the less honour or
obedience. Because they are brethren -- and in that respect on a level
with them. They that live in a religious community know the danger of
this; and that greater grace is requisite to bear with the faults of a
brother, than of an infidel, or man of the world. But rather do them
service - Serve them so much the more diligently. Because they are joint
partakers of the great benefit - Salvation. These things - Paul, the
aged, gives young Timotheus a charge to dwell upon practical holiness.
Less experienced teachers are apt to neglect the superstructure, whilst
they lay the foundation; but of so great importance did St. Paul see it
to enforce obedience to Christ, as well as to preach faith in his blood,
that, after strongly urging the life of faith on professors, he even
adds another charge for the strict observance of it.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p3">3. If any teach otherwise - Than strict practical holiness
in all Its branches. And consent not to sound words - Literally,
healthful words; words that have no taint of falsehood, or tendency to
encourage sin. And the doctrine which is after godliness - Exquisitely
contrived to answer all the ends, and secure every interest, of real
piety.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p4">4. He is puffed up - Which is the cause of his not
consenting to the doctrine which is after inward, practical religion. By
this mark we may know them. Knowing nothing - As he ought to know. Sick
of questions - Doatingly fond of dispute; an evil, but common, disease;
especially where practice is forgotten. Such, indeed, contend earnestly
for singular phrases, and favourite points of their own. Everything
else, however, like the preaching of Christ and his apostles, is all
"law," and "bondage," and "carnal reasoning." Strifes of words - Merely
verbal controversies. Whereof cometh envy - Of the gifts and success of
others. Contention - For the preeminence. Such disputants seldom like
the prosperity of others, or to be less esteemed themselves. Evil
surmisings - It not being their way to think well of those that differ
from themselves in opinion.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p5">5. Supposing that gain is godliness - Thinking the best
religion is the getting of money: a far more common case than is usually
supposed.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p6">6. But godliness with content - The inseparable companion
of true, vital religion. Is great gain - Brings unspeakable profit in
time, as well as eternity.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p7">7. Neither can we carry anything out - To what purpose,
then, do we heap together so many things? O, give me one thing, - a safe
and ready passage to my own country!</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p8">8. Covering - That is, raiment and an house to cover us.
This is all that a Christian needs, and all that his religion allows him
to desire.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p9">9. They that desire to be rich - To have more than these;
for then they would be so far rich; and the very desire banishes
content, and exposes them to ruin. Fall-plunge - A sad gradation! Into
temptation - Miserable food for the soul! And a snare - Or trap.
Dreadful "covering!" And into many foolish and hurtful desires - Which
are sown and fed by having more than we need. Then farewell all hope of
content! What then remains, but destruction for the body, and perdition
for the soul?</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p10">10. Love of money - Commonly called "prudent care" of what
a man has. Is the root - The parent of all manner of evils. Which some
coveting have erred - Literally, missed the mark. They aimed not at
faith, but at something else. And pierced themselves with many sorrows -
From a guilty conscience, tormenting passions, desires contrary to
reason, religion, and one another. How cruel are worldly men to
themselves!</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p11">11. But thou, O man of God - Whatever all the world else
do. A man of God is either a prophet, a messenger of God, or a man
devoted to God; a man of another world. Flee - As from a serpent,
instead of coveting these things. Follow after righteousness - The whole
image of God; though sometimes this word is used, not in the general,
but in the particular, acceptation, meaning only that single branch of
it which is termed justice. Faith - Which is also taken here in the
general and full sense; namely, a divine, supernatural sight of God,
chiefly in respect of his mercy in Christ. This faith is the foundation
of righteousness, the support of godliness, the root of every grace of
the Spirit. Love - This St. Paul intermixes with everything that is
good: he, as it were, penetrates whatever he treats of with love, the
glorious spring of all inward and outward holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p12">12. Fight the good fight of faith - Not about words. Lay
hold on eternal life - Just before thee. Thou hast confessed the good
confession - Perhaps at his baptism: so likewise, ver. 13; but with a
remarkable variation of the expression. Thou hast confessed the good
confession before many witnesses - To which they all assented. He
witnessed the good confession; but Pilate did not assent to it.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p13">13. I charge thee before God, who quickeneth all things -
Who hath quickened thee, and will quicken thee at the great day.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p14">15. Which - Appearing. In his own times - The power, the
knowledge, and the Revelation of which, remain in his eternal mind.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p15">16. Who only hath underived, independent immortality.
Dwelling in light unapproachable - To the highest angel. Whom no man
hath seen, or can see - With bodily eyes. Yet "we shall see him as he
is."</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p16">17. What follows seems to be a kind of a postscript. Charge
the rich in this world - Rich in such beggarly riches as this world
affords. Not to be highminded - O who regards this! Not to think better
of themselves for their money, or anything it can purchase. Neither to
trust in uncertain riches - Which they may lose in an hour; either for
happiness or defense. But in the living God - All the rest is dead clay.
Who giveth us - As it were holding them out to us in his hand. All
things - Which we have. Richly - Freely, abundantly. To enjoy - As his
gift, in him and for him. When we use them thus, we do indeed enjoy all
things. Where else is there any notice taken of the rich, in all the
apostolic writings, save to denounce woes and vengeance upon them?</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p17">18. To do good - To make this their daily employ, that they
may be rich - May abound in all good works. Ready to distribute - Singly
to particular persons. Willing to communicate - To join in all public
works of charity.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p18">19. Treasuring up for themselves a good foundation - Of an
abundant reward, by the free mercy of God. That they may lay hold on
eternal life - This cannot be done by alms-deeds; yet they "come up for
a memorial before God," <scripRef passage="Acts x. 4" id="i.xvi.vii-p18.1" parsed="|Acts|10|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.10.4">Acts x,
4</scripRef>. And the lack even of this may be the cause why God will
withhold grace and salvation from us.</p>

<p id="i.xvi.vii-p19">20. Keep that which is committed to thy trust - The charge
I have given thee, chap. i, 18. Avoid profane empty babblings - How
weary of controversy was this acute disputant! And knowledge falsely so
called - Most of the ancient heretics were great pretenders to
knowledge.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S SECOND EPISTLE TO TIMOTHY" progress="21.43%" prev="i.xvi.vii" next="i.xvii.i" id="i.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2Tim" id="i.xvii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xvii-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S SECOND EPISTLE TO TIMOTHY</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Second Timothy" progress="21.43%" prev="i.xvii" next="i.xvii.ii" id="i.xvii.i">

<p id="i.xvii.i-p1">THIS epistle was probably wrote by St. Paul, during his
second confinement at Rome, not long before his martyrdom. It is, as it
were, the swan's dying song. But though it was wrote many years after
the former, yet they are both of the same kind, and nearly resemble each
other. It has three parts:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xvii.i-p2">I. The inscription, Chap. i. 1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xvii.i-p3">II. An invitation, "Come to me," variously
expressed,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xvii.i-p4">1. Having declared his love to Timothy, 3-5
he exhorts him, " Be not ashamed of me." 6-14 And subjoins various
examples, 15-18</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xvii.i-p5">2. He adds the twofold proposition,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvii.i-p6">1. "Be strong,"</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvii.i-p7">2. "Commit the ministry" to faithful men,.
ii. 1, 2 The former is treated of, 3-13 The latter, 14 With farther
directions concerning his own behaviour, 15- iv.8</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xvii.i-p8">3. "Come quickly." Here St. Paul, 9</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvii.i-p9">1. Mentions his being left alone, 10-12</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvii.i-p10">2. Directs to bring his books, 13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvii.i-p11">3. Gives a caution concerning Alexander, 14,
15</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xvii.i-p12">4. Observes the inconstancy of men, and the
faithfulness of God, 16-18</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xvii.i-p13">4. "Come before winter." Salutations,
19-21</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xvii.i-p14">III. The concluding blessing, 22</p>
<h2 id="i.xvii.i-p14.1">2nd TIMOTHY</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="21.45%" prev="i.xvii.i" next="i.xvii.iii" id="i.xvii.ii">
<h3 id="i.xvii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Tim. I" id="i.xvii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|2Tim|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.1" /> 

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p1">3. Whom I serve from my forefathers - That is, whom both I
and my ancestors served, with a pure conscience - He always worshipped
God according to his conscience, both before and after his conversion
One who stands on the verge of life is much refreshed by the remembrance
of his predecessors, to whom he is going.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p2">4. Being mindful of thy tears - Perhaps frequently shed, as
well as at the apostle's last parting with him.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p3">5. Which dwelt - A word not applied to a transient guest,
but only to a settled inhabitant. First - Probably this was before
Timothy was born, yet not beyond St. Paul's memory.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p4">6. Wherefore - Because I remember this. I remind thee of
stirring up - Literally, blowing up the coals into a flame. The gift of
God - All the spiritual gifts, which the grace of God has given
thee.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p5">7. And let nothing discourage thee, for God hath not given
us - That is, the spirit which God hath given us Christians, is not the
spirit of fear - Or cowardice. But of power - Banishing fear. And love
and sobriety - These animate us in our duties to God, our brethren, and
ourselves. Power and sobriety are two good extremes. Love is between,
the tie and temperament of both; preventing the two bad extremes of
fearfulness and rashness. More is said concerning power, ver. 8;
concerning love, chap. ii, 14, &amp;c.; concerning sobriety, chap. iii,
1, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p6">8. Therefore be not thou ashamed - When fear is banished,
evil shame also flees away. Of the testimony of our Lord - The gospel,
and of testifying the truth of it to all men. Nor of me - The cause of
the servants of God doing his work, cannot be separated from the cause
of God himself. But be thou partaker of the afflictions - Which I endure
for the gospel's sake. According to the power of God - This which
overcomes all things is nervously described in the two next verses.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p7">9. Who hath saved us - By faith. The love of the Father,
the grace of our saviour, and the whole economy of salvation, are here
admirably described. Having called us with an holy calling - Which is
all from God, and claims us all for God. According to his own purpose
and grace - That is, his own gracious purpose. Which was given us -
Fixed for our advantage, before the world began.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p8">10. By the appearing of our saviour - This implies his
whole abode upon earth. Who hath abolished death - Taken away its sting,
and turned it into a blessing. And hath brought life and immortality to
light - Hath clearly revealed by the gospel that immortal life which he
hath purchased for us.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p9">12. That which I have committed to him - My soul. Until
that day - Of his final appearing.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p10">13. The pattern of sound words - The model of pure,
wholesome doctrine.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p11">14. The good thing - This wholesome doctrine.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p12">15. All who are in Asia - Who had attended me at Rome for a
while. Are turned away from me - What, from Paul the aged, the faithful
soldier, and now prisoner of Christ! This was a glorious trial, and
wisely reserved for that time, when he was on the borders of
immortality. Perhaps a little measure of the same spirit might remain
with him under whose picture are those affecting words, "The true effigy
of Francis Xavier, apostle of the Indies, forsaken of all men, dying in
a cottage."</p>

<p id="i.xvii.ii-p13">16. The family of Onesiphorus - As well as himself. Hath
often refreshed me - Both at Ephesus and Rome.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="21.51%" prev="i.xvii.ii" next="i.xvii.iv" id="i.xvii.iii">
<h3 id="i.xvii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Tim. II" id="i.xvii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|2Tim|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.2" /> 

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p1">2. The things - The wholesome doctrine, ver. 13. Commit -
Before thou leavest Ephesus. To faithful men, who will be able, after
thou art gone, to teach others.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p2">4. No man that warreth entangleth himself - Any more than
is unavoidable. In the affairs of this life - With worldly business or
cares. That - Minding war only, he may please his captain. In this and
the next verse there is a plain allusion to the Roman law of arms, and
to that of the Grecian games. According to the former, no soldier was to
engage in any civil employment; according to the latter, none could be
crowned as conqueror, who did not keep strictly to the rules of the
game.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p3">6. Unless he labour first, he will reap no fruit.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p4">8. Of the seed of David - This one genealogy attend to.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p5">9. Is not bound - Not hindered in its course.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p6">10. Therefore - Encouraged by this, that "the word of God
be not bound." I endure all things - See the spirit of a real Christian?
Who would not wish to be likeminded? Salvation is deliverance from all
evil; glory, the enjoyment of all good.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p7">11. Dead with him - Dead to sin, and ready to die for
him.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p8">12. If we deny him - To escape suffering for him.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p9">13. If we believe not - That is, though some believe not,
God will make good all his promises to them that do believe. He cannot
deny himself - His word cannot fail.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p10">14. Remind them - Who are under thy charge. O how many
unnecessary things are thus unprofitably, nay hurtfully, contended
for.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p11">15. A workman that needeth not to be ashamed - Either of
unfaithfulness or unskilfulness. Rightly dividing the word of truth -
Duly explaining and applying the whole scripture, so as to give each
hearer his due portion. But they that give one part of the gospel to all
(the promises and comforts to unawakened, hardened, scoffing men) have
real need to be ashamed.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p12">16. They - Who babble thus will grow worse and worse.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p13">17. And their word - If they go on, will be mischievous as
well as vain, and will eat as a gangrene.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p14">18. Saying the resurrection is already past - Perhaps
asserting that it is only the spiritual passing from death unto
life.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p15">19. But the foundation of God - His truth and faithfulness.
Standeth fast - Can never be overthrown; being as it were sealed with a
seal, which has an inscription on each side: on the one, The Lord
knoweth those that are his; on the other, Let every one who nameth the
name of the Lord, as his Lord, depart from iniquity. Indeed, they only
are his who depart from iniquity. To all others he will say, "I know you
not." <scripRef passage="Matt. vii. 22, 23" id="i.xvii.iii-p15.1" parsed="|Matt|7|22|7|23" osisRef="Bible:Matt.7.22-Matt.7.23">Matt. vii, 22,
23</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p16">20. But in a great house - Such as the church, it is not
strange that there are not only vessels of gold and silver, designed for
honourable uses, but also of wood and of earth - For less honourable
purposes. Yet a vessel even of gold may be put to the vilest use, though
it was not the design of him that made it.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p17">21. If a man purge himself from these - Vessels of
dishonour, so as to have no fellowship with them.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p18">22. Flee youthful desires - Those peculiarly incident to
youth. Follow peace with them - Unity with all true believers. Out of a
pure heart-Youthful desires, destroy this purity: righteousness, faith,
love, peace, accompany it.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p19">24. A servant of the Lord must not - Eagerly or
passionately. Strive - As do the vain wranglers spoken of, verse 23. But
be apt to teach - Chiefly by patience and unwearied assiduity.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p20">25. In meekness - He has often need of zeal, always of
meekness. If haply God - For it is wholly his work. May give them
repentance - The acknowledging of the truth would then quickly
follow.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iii-p21">26. Who - At present are not only captives, but asleep;
utterly insensible of their captivity.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="21.58%" prev="i.xvii.iii" next="i.xvii.v" id="i.xvii.iv">
<h3 id="i.xvii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Tim. III" id="i.xvii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|2Tim|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.3" /> 

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p1">1. In the last days - The time of the gospel dispensation,
commencing at the time of our Lord's death, is peculiarly styled the
last days. Grievous - Troublesome and dangerous.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p2">2. For men - Even in the church. Will be - In great
numbers, and to an higher degree than ever. Lovers of themselves - Only,
not their neighbours, the first root of evil. Lovers of money - The
second.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p3">3. Without natural affection - To their own children.
Intemperate, fierce - Both too soft, and too hard.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p4">4. Lovers of sensual pleasure - Which naturally
extinguishes all love and sense of God.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p5">5. Having a form - An appearance of godliness, but not
regarding, nay, even denying and blaspheming, the inward power and
reality of it. Is not this eminently fulfilled at this day?</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p6">6. Of these - That is, mere formalists.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p7">7. Ever learning - New things. But not the truth of
God.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p8">8. Several ancient writers speak of Jannes and Jambres, as
the chief of the Egyptian magicians. Men of corrupt minds - Impure
notions and wicked inclinations. Void of judgment - Quite ignorant, as
well as careless, of true, spiritual religion.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p9">9. They shall proceed no further--In gaining
proselytes.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p10">12. All that are resolved to live godly - Therefore count
the cost. Art thou resolved? In Christ - Out of Christ there is no
godliness. Shall suffer persecution - More or less. There is no
exception. Either the truth of scripture fails, or those that think they
are religious, and are not persecuted, in some shape or other, on that
very account, deceive themselves.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p11">13. Deceiving and being deceived - He who has once begun to
deceive others is both the less likely to recover from his own error,
and the more ready to embrace the errors of other men.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p12">14. From whom - Even from me a teacher approved of God.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p13">15. From an infant thou hast known the holy scriptures - Of
the Old Testament. These only were extant when Timothy was an infant.
Which are able to make thee wise unto salvation, through faith in the
Messiah that was to come. How much more are the Old and New Testament
together able, in God's hand, to make us more abundantly wise unto
salvation! Even such a measure of present salvation as was not known
before Jesus was glorified.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p14">16. All scripture is inspired of God - The Spirit of God
not only once inspired those who wrote it, but continually inspires,
supernaturally assists, those that read it with earnest prayer. Hence it
is so profitable for doctrine, for instruction of the ignorant, for the
reproof or conviction of them that are in error or sin, for the
correction or amendment of whatever is amiss, and for instructing or
training up the children of God in all righteousness.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.iv-p15">17. That the man of God - He that is united to and approved
of God. May be perfect - Blameless himself, and throughly furnished - By
the scripture, either to teach, reprove, correct, or train up
others.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="21.63%" prev="i.xvii.iv" next="i.xviii" id="i.xvii.v">
<h3 id="i.xvii.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Tim. IV" id="i.xvii.v-p0.2" parsed="|2Tim|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.4" /> 

<p id="i.xvii.v-p1">1. I charge thee therefore - This is deduced from the whole
preceding chapter. At his appearing and his kingdom - That is, at his
appearing in the kingdom of glory.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p2">2. Be instant - Insist on, urge these things in season, out
of season - That is, continually, at all times and places. It might be
translated, with and without opportunity - Not only when a fair occasion
is given: even when there is none, one must be made.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p3">3. For they will heap up teachers - Therefore thou hast
need of "all longsuffering." According to their own desires - Smooth as
they can wish. Having itching ears - Fond of novelty and variety, which
the number of new teachers, as well as their empty, soft, or
philosophical discourses, pleased. Such teachers, and such hearers,
seldom are much concerned with what is strict or to the purpose. Heap to
themselves - Not enduring sound doctrine, they will reject the sound
preachers, and gather together all that suit their own taste. Probably
they send out one another as teachers, and so are never at a loss for
numbers.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p4">5. Watch - An earnest, constant, persevering exercise. The
scripture watching, or waiting, implies steadfast faith, patient hope,
labouring love, unceasing prayer; yea, the mighty exertion of all the
affections of the soul that a man is capable of. In all things -
Whatever you are doing, yet in that, and in all things, watch. Do the
work of an evangelist - Which was next to that of an apostle.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p5">6. The time of my departure is at hand - So undoubtedly God
had shown him. I am ready to be offered up - Literally, to be poured
out, as the wine and oil were on the ancient sacrifices.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p6">8. The crown of that righteousness - Which God has imputed
to me and wrought in me. Will render to all - This increases the joy of
Paul, and encourages Timotheus. Many of these St. Paul himself had
gained. That have loved his appearing - Which only a real Christian can
do. I say a real Christian, to comply with the mode of the times: else
they would not understand, although the word Christian necessarily
implies whatsoever is holy, as God is holy. Strictly speaking, to join
real or sincere to a word of so complete an import, is grievously to
debase its noble signification, and is like adding long to eternity or
wide to immensity.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p7">9. Come to me - Both that he might comfort him, and be
strengthened by him. Timotheus himself is said to have suffered at
Ephesus.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p8">10. Demas - Once my fellowlabourer, <scripRef passage="Phil. i. 24" id="i.xvii.v-p8.1" parsed="|Phil|1|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.1.24">Phil. i, 24</scripRef>. Hath forsaken me. Crescens, probably a preacher also, is
gone, with my consent, to Galatia, Titus to Dalmatia, having now left
Crete. These either went with him to Rome, or visited him there.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p9">11. Only Luke - Of my fellowlabourers, is with me - But God
is with me; and it is enough. Take Mark - Who, though he once "departed
from the work," is now again profitable to me.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p10">13. The cloak - Either the toga, which belonged to him as a
Roman citizen, or an upper garment, which might be needful as winter
came on. Which I left at Troas with Carpus - Who was probably his host
there. Especially the parchments - The books written on parchment.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p11">14. The Lord will reward him - This he spoke
prophetically.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p12">16. All - My friends and companions. Forsook me - And do we
expect to find such as will not forsake us? My first defense - Before
the savage emperor Nero.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p13">17. The preaching - The gospel which we preach.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p14">18. And the Lord will deliver me from every evil work -
Which is far more than delivering me from death. Yea, and, over and
above, preserve me unto his heavenly kingdom - Far better than that of
Nero.</p>

<p id="i.xvii.v-p15">20. When I came on, Erastus abode at Corinth - Being
chamberlain of the city, <scripRef passage="Rom. xvi. 23" id="i.xvii.v-p15.1" parsed="|Rom|16|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.16.23">Rom. xvi,
23</scripRef>. But Trophimus I have left sick - Not having power (as
neither had any of the apostles) to work miracles when he pleased, but
only when God pleased.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO TITUS" progress="21.69%" prev="i.xvii.v" next="i.xviii.i" id="i.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Tit" id="i.xviii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xviii-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO TITUS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Titus" progress="21.69%" prev="i.xviii" next="i.xviii.ii" id="i.xviii.i">

<p id="i.xviii.i-p1">TITUS was converted from heathenism by St. Paul, and, as it
seems, very early; since the apostle accounted him as his brother at his
first going into Macedonia: and he managed and settled the churches
there, when St. Paul thought not good to go thither himself. He had now
left him at Crete, to regulate the churches; to assist him wherein, he
wrote this epistle, as is generally believed, after the First, and
before the Second, to Timothy. The tenor and style are much alike in
this and in those; and they cast much light on each other, and are
worthy the serious attention of all Christian ministers and churches in
all ages. This epistle has four parts:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xviii.i-p2">I. The inscription, Chap. i, 1-4</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xviii.i-p3">II. The instruction of Titus to this
effect</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xviii.i-p4">1. Ordain good presbyters, 5-9</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xviii.i-p5">2. Such are especially needful at Crete,
10-12</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xviii.i-p6">3. Reprove and admonish the Cretans,
13-16</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xviii.i-p7">4. Teach aged men and women, ii. 1-5 And
young men, being a pattern to them, 6-8 And servants, urging them by a
glorious motive,. 9-15</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xviii.i-p8">5. Press obedience to magistrates, and
gentleness to all men, iii. 1-2</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xviii.i-p9">Enforcing it by the same motive, 3-7</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xviii.i-p10">6. Good works are to be done, foolish
questions avoided. heretics shunned, 8-11</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xviii.i-p11">III. An invitation of Titus to Nicopolis,
with some admonitions, 12-14</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xviii.i-p12">IV. The conclusion,</p>
<h2 id="i.xviii.i-p12.1">TITUS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="21.72%" prev="i.xviii.i" next="i.xviii.iii" id="i.xviii.ii">
<h3 id="i.xviii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Titus I" id="i.xviii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Titus|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Titus.1" /> 

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p1">1. Paul, a servant of God, and an apostle of Jesus Christ -
Titles suitable to the person of Paul, and the office he was assigning
to Titus. According to the faith - The propagating of which is the
proper business of an apostle. A servant of God - According to the faith
of the elect. An apostle of Jesus Christ - According to the knowledge of
the truth. We serve God according to the measure of our faith: we fulfil
our public office according to the measure of our knowledge. The truth
that is after godliness - Which in every point runs parallel with and
supports the vital, spiritual worship of God; and, indeed, has no other
end or scope. These two verses contain the sum of Christianity, which
Titus was always to have in his eye. Of the elect of God - Of all real
Christians</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p2">2. In hope of eternal life - The grand motive and
encouragement of every apostle and every servant of God. Which God
promised before the world began - To Christ, our Head.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p3">3. And he hath in his own times - At sundry times; and his
own times are fittest for his own work. What creature dares ask, "Why no
sooner?" Manifested his word - Containing that promise, and the whole
"truth which is after godliness." Through the preaching wherewith I am
intrusted according to the commandment of God our saviour - And who
dares exercise this office on any less authority?</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p4">4. My own son - Begot in the same image of God, and
repaying a paternal with a filial affection. The common faith - Common
to me and all my spiritual children.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p5">5. The things which are wanting - Which I had not time to
settle myself. Ordain elders - Appoint the most faithful, zealous men to
watch over the rest. Their character follows, <scripRef passage="Tit i. 6-9" id="i.xviii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Titus|1|6|1|9" osisRef="Bible:Titus.1.6-Titus.1.9">Tit i, 6-9</scripRef>. These were the elders, or bishops, that Paul approved
of;-men that had living faith, a pure conscience, a blameless life.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p6">6. The husband of one wife - Surely the Holy Ghost, by
repeating this so often, designed to leave the Romanists without
excuse.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p7">7. As the steward of God - To whom he intrusts immortal
souls. Not selfwilled - Literally, pleasing himself; but all men "for
their good to edification." Not passionate - But mild, yielding,
tender.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p8">9. As he hath been taught - Perhaps it might be more
literally rendered, according to the teaching, or doctrine, of the
apostles; alluding to <scripRef passage="Acts ii. 42" id="i.xviii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Acts|2|42|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.2.42">Acts ii,
42</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p9">10. They of the circumcision - The Jewish converts.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p10">11. Stopped - The word properly means, to put a bit into
the mouth of an unruly horse.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p11">12. A prophet - So all poets were anciently called; but,
besides, Diogenes Laertius says that Epimenides, the Cretan poet,
foretold many things. Evil wild beasts - Fierce and savage.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p12">14. Commandments of men - The Jewish or other teachers,
whoever they were that turned from the truth.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.ii-p13">15. To the pure - Those whose hearts are purified by faith
this we allow. All things are pure - All kinds of meat; the Mosaic
distinction between clean and unclean meats being now taken away. But to
the defiled and unbelieving nothing is pure - The apostle joins defiled
and unbelieving, to intimate that nothing can be clean without a true
faith: for both the understanding and conscience, those leading powers
of the soul, are polluted; consequently, so is the man and all he
does.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="21.77%" prev="i.xviii.ii" next="i.xviii.iv" id="i.xviii.iii">
<h3 id="i.xviii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Titus II" id="i.xviii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Titus|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Titus.2" /> 

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p1">1. Wholesome - Restoring and preserving spiritual
health.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p2">2. Vigilant - As veteran soldiers, not easily to be
surprised. Patience - A virtue particularly needful for and becoming
them. Serious - Not drolling or diverting on the brink of eternity.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p3">3. In behaviour - The particulars whereof follow. As
becometh holiness - Literally, observing an holy decorum. Not slanderers
- Or evil-speakers. Not given to much wine - If they use a little for
their often infirmities. Teachers - Age and experience call them so to
be. Let them teach good only.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p4">4. That they instruct the young women - These Timothy was
to instruct himself; Titus, by the elder women. To love their husbands,
their children - With a tender, temperate, holy, wise affection. O how
hard a lesson.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p5">5. Discreet - Particularly in the love of their children.
Chaste - Particularly in the love of their husbands. Keepers at home -
Whenever they are not called out by works of necessity, piety, and
mercy. Good - Well tempered, sweet, soft, obliging. Obedient to their
husbands - Whose will, in all things lawful, is a rule to the wife. That
the word of God be not blasphemed - Or evil spoken of; particularly by
unbelieving husbands, who lay all the blame on the religion of their
wives.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p6">6. To be discreet - A virtue rarely found in youth.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p7">7. Showing thyself a pattern - Titus himself was then
young. In the doctrine which thou teachest in public: as to matter,
uncorruptness; as to the manner of delivering it, seriousness -
Weightiness, solemnity.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p8">8. Wholesome speech - In private conversation.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p9">9. Please them in all things - Wherein it can be done
without sin. Not answering again - Though blamed unjustly. This honest
servants are most apt to do. Not stealing - Not taking or giving any
thing without their master's leave: this fair-spoken servants are apt to
do.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p10">10. Showing all good fidelity - Soft, obliging faithfulness
That they may adorn the doctrine of God our saviour - More than St. Paul
says of kings. How he raises the lowness of his subject! So may they,
the lowness of their condition.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p11">11. The saving grace of God - So it is in its nature,
tendency, and design. Hath appeared to all men - High and low.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p12">12. Instructing us - All who do not reject it. That, having
renounced ungodliness - Whatever is contrary to the fear and love of
God. And worldly desires - Which are opposite to sobriety and
righteousness. We should live soberly - In all purity and holiness.
Sobriety, in the scripture sense, is rather the whole temper of a man,
than a single virtue in him. It comprehends all that is opposite to the
drowsiness of sin, the folly of ignorance, the unholiness of disorderly
passions. Sobriety is no less than all the powers of the soul being
consistently and constantly awake, duly governed by heavenly prudence,
and entirely conformable to holy affections. And righteously - Doing to
all as we would they should do to us. And godly - As those who are
consecrated to God both in heart and life.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p13">13. Looking - With eager desire. For that glorious
appearing - Which we hope for. Of the great God, even our saviour Jesus
Christ - So that, if there be (according to the Arian scheme) a great
God and a little God, Christ is not the little God, but the great
one.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p14">14. Who gave himself for us - To die in our stead. That he
might redeem us - Miserable bondslaves, as well from the power and the
very being, as from the guilt, of all our sins.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iii-p15">15. Let no man despise thee - That is, let none have any
just cause to despise thee. Yet they surely will. Men who know not God
will despise a true minister of his word.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="21.84%" prev="i.xviii.iii" next="i.xix" id="i.xviii.iv">
<h3 id="i.xviii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Titus III" id="i.xviii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Titus|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Titus.3" /> 

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p1">1. Remind them - All the Cretan Christians. To be subject -
Passively, not resisting. To principalities - Supreme. And powers -
Subordinate governors. And to obey - Them actively, so far as conscience
permits.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p2">2. To speak evil - Neither of them nor any man. Not to be
quarrelsome - To assault none. To be gentle - When assaulted. Toward all
men - Even those who are such as we were.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p3">3. For we - And as God hath dealt with us, so ought we to
deal with our neighbour. Were without understanding - Wholly ignorant of
God. And disobedient - When he was declared to us.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p4">4. When the love of God appeared - By the light of his
Spirit to our inmost soul.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p5">5. Not by works - In this important passage the apostle
presents us with a delightful view of our redemption. Herein we
have,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xviii.iv-p6">1. The cause of it; not our works or
righteousness, but "the kindness and love of God our saviour."</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xviii.iv-p7">2. The effects; which are,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xviii.iv-p8">(1.) Justification; "being justified,"
pardoned and accepted through the alone merits of Christ, not from any
desert in us, but according to his own mercy, "by his grace," his free,
unmerited goodness.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xviii.iv-p9">(2.) Sanctification, expressed by the laver
of regeneration, (that is, baptism, the thing signified, as well as the
outward sign,) and the renewal of the Holy Ghost; which purifies the
soul, as water cleanses the body, and renews it in the whole image of
God.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xviii.iv-p10">3. The consummation of all; - that we might
become heirs of eternal life, and live now in the joyful hope of it.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p11">8. Be careful to excel in good works - Though the apostle
does not lay these for the foundation, yet he brings them in at their
proper place, and then mentions them, not slightly, but as affairs of
great importance. He desires that all believers should be careful - Have
their thoughts upon them: use their best contrivance, their utmost
endeavours, not barely to practice, but to excel, to be eminent and
distinguished in them: because, though they are not the ground of our
reconciliation with God, yet they are amiable and honourable to the
Christian profession. And profitable to men - Means of increasing the
everlasting happiness both of ourselves and others.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p12">10. An heretic (after a first and second admonition) reject
- Avoid, leave to himself. This is the only place, in the whole
scripture, where this word heretic occurs; and here it evidently means,
a man that obstinately persists in contending about "foolish questions,"
and thereby occasions strife and animosities, schisms and parties in the
church. This, and this alone, is an heretic in the scripture sense; and
his punishment likewise is here fixed. Shun, avoid him, leave him to
himself. As for the Popish sense, "A man that errs in fundamentals,"
although it crept, with many other things, early into the church, yet it
has no shadow of foundation either in the Old or New Testament.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p13">11. Such an one is perverted - In his heart, at least. And
sinneth, being self-condemned - Being convinced in his own conscience
that he acts wrong.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p14">12. When I shall send Artemas or Tychicus - To succeed thee
in thy office. Titus was properly an evangelist, who, according to the
nature of that office, had no fixed residence; but presided over other
elders, wherever he travelled from place to place, assisting each of the
apostles according to the measure of his abilities. Come to me to
Nicopolis - Very probably not the Nicopolis in Macedonia, as the vulgar
subscription asserts: (indeed, none of those subscriptions at the end of
St. Paul's epistles are of any authority:) rather it was a town of the
same name which lay upon the sea-coast of Epirus. For I have determined
to winter there - Hence it appears, he was not there yet; if so, he
would have said, to winter here. Consequently, this letter was not
written from thence.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p15">13. Send forward Zenas the lawyer - Either a Roman lawyer
or an expounder of the Jewish law.</p>

<p id="i.xviii.iv-p16">14. And let ours - All our brethren at Crete. Learn - Both
by thy admonition and example. Perhaps they had not before assisted
Zenas and Apollos as they ought to have done.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO PHILEMON" progress="21.91%" prev="i.xviii.iv" next="i.xix.i" id="i.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Phlm" id="i.xix-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xix-p0.2">NOTES ON ST. PAUL'S EPISTLE TO PHILEMON</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Philemon" progress="21.91%" prev="i.xix" next="i.xix.ii" id="i.xix.i">

<p id="i.xix.i-p1">ONESIMUS, a servant to Philemon, an eminent person in
Colosse, ran away from his master to Rome. Here he was converted to
Christianity by St. Paul, who sent him back to his master with this
letter. It seems, Philemon not only pardoned, but gave him his liberty;
seeing Ignatius makes mention of him, as succeeding Timotheus at
Ephesus. The letter has three parts</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xix.i-p2">I. The inscription, 1-3</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xix.i-p3">II. After commending Philemon's faith and
love,. 4-7 He desires him to receive Onesimus again,. 8-21 And to
prepare a lodging for himself, 22</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xix.i-p4">III. The conclusion, 23-23</p>
<h2 id="i.xix.i-p4.1">PHILEMON</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="21.92%" prev="i.xix.i" next="i.xx" id="i.xix.ii">
<h3 id="i.xix.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Philemon i" id="i.xix.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Phlm|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phlm.1.1" /> 

<p id="i.xix.ii-p1">1. This single epistle infinitely transcends all the wisdom
of the world. And it gives us a specimen how Christians ought to treat
of secular affairs from higher principles. Paul a prisoner of Christ -
To whom, as such, Philemon could deny nothing. And Timotheus - This was
written before the second epistle to Timothy, ver. xxii.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p2">2. To Apphia - His wife, to whom also the business in part
belonged. And the church in thy house - The Christians who meet
there.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p3">5. Hearing - Probably from Onesimus.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p4">6. I pray that the communication of thy faith may become
effectual - That is, that thy faith may be effectually communicated to
others, who see and acknowledge thy piety and charity.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p5">7. The saints - To whom Philemon's house was open, verse
ii.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p6">8. I might be bold in Christ - Through the authority he
hath given me.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p7">9. Yet out of love I rather entreat thee - In how handsome
a manner does the apostle just hint, and immediately drop, the
consideration of his power to command, and tenderly entreat Philemon to
hearken to his friend, his aged friend, and now prisoner for Christ!
With what endearment, in the next verse, does he call Onesimus his son,
before he names his name! And as soon as he had mentioned it, with what
fine address does he just touch on his former faults, and instantly pass
on to the happy change that was now made upon him! So disposing Philemon
to attend to his request, and the motives wherewith he was going to
enforce it.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p8">10. Whom I have begotten in my bonds - The son of my
age.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p9">11. Now profitable - None should be expected to be a good
servant before he is a good man. He manifestly alludes to his name,
Onesimus, which signifies profitable.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p10">12. Receive him, that is, my own bowels - Whom I love as my
own soul. Such is the natural affection of a father in Christ toward his
spiritual children.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p11">13. To serve me in thy stead - To do those services for me
which thou, if present, wouldest gladly have done thyself.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p12">14. That thy benefit might not be by constraint - For
Philemon could not have refused it.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p13">15. God might permit him to be separated (a soft word) for
a season, that thou mightest have him forever - Both on earth and in
heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p14">16. In the flesh - As a dutiful servant. In the Lord - As a
fellow- Christian.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p15">17. If thou accountest me a partner - So that thy things
are mine, and mine are thine.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p16">19. I will repay it - If thou requirest it. Not to say,
that then owest me thyself - It cannot be expressed, how great our
obligation is to those who have gained our souls to Christ. Beside -
Receiving Onesimus.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p17">20. Refresh my bowels in Christ - Give me the most
exquisite and Christian pleasure.</p>

<p id="i.xix.ii-p18">22. Given to you - Restored to liberty.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE EPISTLE TO THE HEBREWS" progress="21.97%" prev="i.xix.ii" next="i.xx.i" id="i.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb" id="i.xx-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xx-p0.2">NOTES ON THE EPISTLE TO THE HEBREWS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Hebrews" progress="21.97%" prev="i.xx" next="i.xx.ii" id="i.xx.i">

<p id="i.xx.i-p1">IT is agreed by the general tenor of antiquity that this
epistle was written by St. Paul, whose other epistles were sent to the
gentile converts; this only to the Hebrews. But this improper
inscription was added by some later hand. It was sent to the Jewish
Hellenist Christians, dispersed through various countries. St. Paul's
method and style are easily observed therein. He places, as usual, the
proposition and division before the treatise, chap. ii, 17; he subjoins
the exhortatory to the doctrinal part, quotes the same scriptures, chap.
i, 6; ii, 8; x, 30, 38, 6; and uses the same expressions as elsewhere.
But why does he not prefix his name, which, it is plain from chap. xiii,
19 was dear to them to whom he wrote? Because he prefixes no
inscription, in which, if at all, the name would have been mentioned.
The ardour of his spirit carries aim directly upon his subject, (just
like St. John in his First Epistle,) and throws back his usual
salutation and thanksgiving to the conclusion. This epistle of St. Paul,
and both those of St. Peter, (one may add, that of St. James and of St.
Jude also,) were written both to the same persons, dispersed through
Pontus, Galatia, and other countries, and nearly at the same time. St.
Paul suffered at Rome, three years before the destruction of Jerusalem.
Therefore this epistle likewise, was written while the temple was
standing. St. Peter wrote a little before his martyrdom, and refers to
the epistles of St. Paul; this in particular. The scope of it is, to
confirm their faith in Christ; and this he does by demonstrating his
glory. All the parts of it are full of the most earnest and pointed
admonitions and exhortations; and they go on in one tenor, the particle
therefore everywhere connecting the doctrine and the use. The sum is,
The glory of Christ appears,</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xx.i-p2">I. From comparing with him the prophets and
angels, i. 1-14 Therefore we ought to give heed to him, ii. 1-4</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xx.i-p3">II. From his passion and consummation. Here
we may observe,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xx.i-p4">1. The proposition and sum, 5-9</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xx.i-p5">2. The treatise itself. We have a perfect
author of salvation, who suffered for our sake, that he might be, (1.) a
merciful, and (2.) a faithful, (3.) high priest,. 10-13 These three are
particularly explained, his passion and consummation being continually
interwoven</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.i-p6">1. He has the virtues of an high priest</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xx.i-p7">a. He is faithful, iii.1 Therefore be ye not
unfaithful iv.13</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xx.i-p8">b. He is merciful, 15 Therefore come to him
with confidence v.3</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.i-p9">2. He is called of God an high priest.
Here,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xx.i-p10">a. The sum is proposed, 4-10 With a summary
exhortation 11- vi. 20</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xx.i-p11">b. The point is copiously,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xx.i-p12">1. Explained. We have a great high
priest,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.xx.i-p13">1. Such as is described in the hundred and
tenth Psalm After the order of Melchisedec, vii. 1-19 Established by an
oath, 20-22 For ever, 23-28</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.xx.i-p14">2. Therefore peculiarly excellent-Heavenly,
viii. 1-6 Of the new covenant, 7-13 By whom we have an entrance into the
sanctuary ix. 1 x. 18</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xx.i-p15">2. Applied. Therefore,</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.xx.i-p16">1. Believe, hope, love 19-25 These three are
farther inculcated,</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.xx.i-p17">a. Faith, with patience, 26-39 Which, after
the example of the ancients,. xi.1 xii.1 And of Christ himself, 2, 3 Is
to be exercised, 4-11 Cheerfully, peaceably, holily, 12-17</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.xx.i-p18">b. Hope, 18-20</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.xx.i-p19">c. Love, C.xiii. 1-6</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.xx.i-p20">2. In order to grow in these graces, make use
of The remembrance of your former, 7-16 The vigilance of your present,
pastors, 17-19 To this period, and to the whole epistle, answers The
prayer, the doxology, and the mild conclusion, 20-25 There are many
comparisons in this epistle, which may be nearly reduced to two
heads:</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.xx.i-p21">1. The prophets, the angels, Moses, Joshua,
Aaron, are great; but Jesus Christ is infinitely greater</p>

<p class="List7" id="i.xx.i-p22">2. The ancient believers enjoyed high
privileges; but Christian believers enjoy far higher. To illustrate
this, examples both of happiness and misery are everywhere interspersed:
so that in this epistle there is a kind of recapitulation of the whole
Old Testament. In this also Judaism is abrogated, and Christianity
carried to its height.</p>
<h2 id="i.xx.i-p22.1">HEBREWS</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="22.04%" prev="i.xx.i" next="i.xx.iii" id="i.xx.ii">
<h3 id="i.xx.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. I" id="i.xx.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.1" /> 

<p id="i.xx.ii-p1">1. God, who at sundry times - The creation was revealed in
the time of Adam; the last judgment, in the time of Enoch: and so at
various times, and in various degrees, more explicit knowledge was
given. In divers manners - In visions, in dreams, and by Revelations of
various kinds. Both these are opposed to the one entire and perfect
Revelation which he has made to us by Jesus Christ. The very number of
the prophets showed that they prophesied only "in part." Of old - There
were no prophets for a large tract of time before Christ came, that the
great Prophet might be the more earnestly expected. Spake - A part is
put for the whole; implying every kind of divine communication. By the
prophets - The mention of whom is a virtual declaration that the apostle
received the whole Old Testament, and was not about to advance any
doctrine in contradiction to it. Hath in these last times - Intimating
that no other Rev. is to be expected. Spoken - All things, and in the
most perfect manner. By his Son - Alone. The Son spake by the apostles.
The majesty of the Son of God is proposed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.ii-p2">1. Absolutely, by the very name of Son, verse
1, and by three glorious predicates, - "whom he hath appointed," "by
whom he made," who "sat down;" whereby he is described from the
beginning to the consummation of all things, ver. 2, 3</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.ii-p3">2. Comparatively to angels, ver. 4. The proof
of this proposition immediately follows: the name of Son being proved,
ver. 5; his being "heir of all things," ver. 6-9; his making the worlds,
ver. 10- 12 his sitting at God's right hand, ver. 13, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p4">2. Whom he hath appointed heir of all things - After the
name of Son, his inheritance is mentioned. God appointed him the heir
long before he made the worlds, <scripRef passage="Eph. iii. 11" id="i.xx.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Eph|3|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.3.11">Eph.
iii, 11</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Prov. viii. 22" id="i.xx.ii-p4.2" parsed="|Prov|8|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.8.22">Prov. viii,
22</scripRef>, &amp;c. The Son is the firstborn, born before all things:
the heir is a term relating to the creation which followed, ver. 6. By
whom he also made the worlds - Therefore the Son was before all worlds.
His glory reaches from everlasting to everlasting, though God spake by
him to us only "in these last days."</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p5">3. Who sat down - The third of these glorious predicates,
with which three other particulars are interwoven, which are mentioned
likewise, and in the same order, <scripRef passage="Colossians i. 15, 17, 20" id="i.xx.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Col|1|15|0|0;|Col|1|17|0|0;|Col|1|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.1.15 Bible:Col.1.17 Bible:Col.1.20">Colossians i, 15, 17,
20</scripRef>. Who, being - The glory which he received in his exaltation
at the right hand of the Father no angel was capable of; but the Son
alone, who likewise enjoyed it long before. The brightness of his glory
- Glory is the nature of God revealed in its brightness. The express
image - Or stamp. Whatever the Father is, is exhibited in the Son, as a
seal in the stamp on wax. Of his person - Or substance. The word denotes
the unchangeable perpetuity of divine life and power. And sustaining all
things - Visible and invisible, in being. By the word of his power -
That is, by his powerful word. When he had by himself - Without any
Mosaic rites or ceremonies. Purged our sins - In order to which it was
necessary he should for a time divest himself of his glory. In this
chapter St. Paul describes his glory chiefly as he is the Son of God;
afterwards, ver. 6, &amp;c., the glory of the man Christ Jesus. He
speaks, indeed, briefly of the former before his humiliation, but
copiously after his exaltation; as from hence the glory he had from
eternity began to be evidently seen. Both his purging our sins, and
sitting on the right hand of God, are largely treated of in the seven
following chapters. Sat down - The priests stood while they ministered:
sitting, therefore, denotes the consummation of his sacrifice. This
word, sat down, contains the scope, the theme, and the sum, of the
epistle.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p6">4. This verse has two clauses, the latter of which is
treated of, ver. 5; the former, ver. 13. Such transpositions are also
found in the other epistles of St. Paul, but in none so frequently as in
this. The Jewish doctors were peculiarly fond of this figure, and used
it much in all their writings. The apostle therefore, becoming all
things to all men, here follows the same method. All the inspired
writers were readier in all the figures of speech than the most
experienced orators. Being - By his exaltation, after he had been lower
than them, chap. ii, 9. So much higher than the angels - It was
extremely proper to observe this, because the Jews gloried in their law,
as it was delivered by the ministration of angels. How much more may we
glory in the gospel, which was given, not by the ministry of angels, but
of the very Son of God! As he hath by inheritance a more excellent name
- Because he is the Son of God, he inherits that name, in right whereof
he inherits all things His inheriting that name is more ancient than all
worlds; his inheriting all things, as ancient as all things. Than they -
This denotes an immense preeminence. The angels do not inherit all
things, but are themselves a portion of the Son's inheritance, whom they
worship as their Lord.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p7">5. Thou art my Son - God of God, Light of Light. This day
have I begotten thee - I have begotten thee from eternity, which, by its
unalter able permanency of duration, is one continued, unsuccessive day.
I will be to him a Father, and he shall be to me a Son - I will own
myself to be his Father, and him to be my Son, by eminent tokens of my
peculiar love The former clause relates to his natural Sonship, by an
eternal, inconceivable generation; the other, to his Father's
acknowledgment and treatment of him as his incarnate Son. Indeed this
promise related immediately to Solomon, but in a far higher sense to the
Messiah. <scripRef passage="Psalm ii. 7" id="i.xx.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Ps|2|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.2.7">Psalm ii, 7</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="2 Sam. vii. 14" id="i.xx.ii-p7.2" parsed="|2Sam|7|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.7.14">2 Sam. vii, 14</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p8">6. And again - That is, in another scripture. He - God.
Saith, when he bringeth in his first-begotten - This appellation
includes that of Son, together with the rights of primogeniture, which
the first- begotten Son of God enjoys, in a manner not communicable to
any creature. Into the world - Namely, at his incarnation. He saith, Let
all the angels of God worship him - So much higher was he, when in his
lowest estate, than the highest angel. <scripRef passage="Psalm xcvii. 7" id="i.xx.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|97|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.97.7">Psalm xcvii, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p9">7. Who maketh his angels - This implies, they are only
creatures, whereas the Son is eternal, ver. 8; and the Creator himself,
ver. 10. Spirits and a flame of fire - Which intimates not only their
office, but also their nature; which is excellent indeed, the metaphor
being taken from the most swift, subtle, and efficacious things on
earth; but nevertheless infinitely below the majesty of the Son. <scripRef passage="Psalm civ. 4" id="i.xx.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Ps|104|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.104.4">Psalm civ, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p10">8. O God - God, in the singular number, is never in
scripture used absolutely of any but the supreme God. Thy reign, of
which the scepter is the ensign, is full of justice and equity. <scripRef passage="Psalm xlv. 6, 7" id="i.xx.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Ps|45|6|45|7" osisRef="Bible:Ps.45.6-Ps.45.7">Psalm xlv, 6, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p11">9. Thou hast loved righteousness and hated iniquity - Thou
art infinitely pure and holy. Therefore God - Who, as thou art Mediator,
is thy God. Hath anointed thee with the oil of gladness - With the Holy
Ghost, the fountain of joy. Above thy fellows - Above all the children
of men.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p12">10. Thou - The same to whom the discourse is addressed in
the preceding verse. <scripRef passage="Psalm cii. 25, 26" id="i.xx.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Ps|102|25|102|26" osisRef="Bible:Ps.102.25-Ps.102.26">Psalm cii,
25, 26</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p13">12. As a mantle - With all ease. They shall be changed -
Into new heavens and a new earth. But thou art eternally the same.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p14">13. <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 1" id="i.xx.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Ps|110|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.1">Psalm cx,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ii-p15">14. Are they not all - Though of various orders.
Ministering spirits, sent forth - Ministering before God, sent forth to
men. To attend on them - In numerous offices of protection, care, and
kindness. Who - Having patiently continued in welldoing, shall inherit
everlasting salvation.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="22.17%" prev="i.xx.ii" next="i.xx.iv" id="i.xx.iii">
<h3 id="i.xx.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. II" id="i.xx.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.2" /> 

<p id="i.xx.iii-p1">In this and the two following chapters the apostle subjoins
an exhortation, answering each head of the preceding chapter.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p2">1. Lest we should let them slip - As water out of a leaky
vessel. So the Greek word properly signifies.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p3">2. In giving the law, God spoke by angels; but in
proclaiming the gospel, by his Son. Steadfast - Firm and valid. Every
transgression - Commission of sin. Every disobedience - Omission of
duty.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p4">3. So great a salvation - A deliverance from so great
wickedness and misery, into so great holiness and happiness. This was
first spoken of (before he came it was not known) by Him who is the Lord
- of angels as well as men. And was confirmed to us - Of this age, even
every article of it. By them that had heard him - And had been
themselves also both eye-witnesses and ministers of the word.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p5">4. By signs and wonders - While he lived. And various
miracles and distributions of the Holy Ghost - Miraculous gifts,
distributed after his exaltation. According to his will - Not theirs who
received them.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p6">5. This verse contains a proof of the third; the greater
the salvation is, and the more glorious the Lord whom we despise, the
greater will be our punishment. God hath not subjected the world to come
- That is, the dispensation of the Messiah; which being to succeed the
Mosaic was usually styled by the Jews, the world to come, although it is
still in great measure to come Whereof we now speak - Of which I am now
speaking. In this last great dispensation the Son alone presides.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p7">6. What is man - To the vast expanse of heaven, to the moon
and the stars which thou hast ordained! This psalm seems to have been
composed by David, in a clear, moonshiny, and starlight night, while he
was contemplating the wonderful fabric of heaven; because in his
magnificent description of its luminaries, he takes no notice of the
sun, the most glorious of them all. The words here cited concerning
dominion were doubtless in some sense applicable to Adam; although in
their complete and highest sense, they belong to none but the second
Adam. Or the son of man, that thou visitest him - The sense rises: we
are mindful of him that is absent; but to visit, denotes the care of a
present God. <scripRef passage="Psalm viii. 4" id="i.xx.iii-p7.1" parsed="|Ps|8|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.8.4">Psalm viii, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p8">7. Thou hast made him - Adam. A little lower than the
angels - The Hebrew is, a little lower than (that is, next to) God. Such
was man as he came out of the hands of his Creator: it seems, the
highest of all created beings. But these words are also in a farther
sense, as the apostle here shows, applicable to the Son of God. It
should be remembered that the apostles constantly cited the Septuagint
translation, very frequently without any variation. It was not their
business, in writing to the Jews, who at that time had it in high
esteem, to amend or alter this, which would of consequence have
occasioned disputes without end.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p9">8. Now this putting all things under him, implies that
there is nothing that is not put under him. But it is plain, this is not
done now, with regard to man in general.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p10">9. It is done only with regard to Jesus, God-Man, who is
now crowned with glory and honour - As a reward for his having suffered
death. He was made a little lower than the angels - Who cannot either
suffer or die. That by the grace of God, he might taste death - An
expression denoting both the reality of his death, and the shortness of
its continuance. For every man - That ever was or will be born into the
world.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p11">10. In this verse the apostle expresses, in his own words,
what he expressed before in those of the Psalmist. It became him - It
was suitable to all his attributes, both to his justice, goodness, and
wisdom. For whom - As their ultimate end. And by whom - As their first
cause. Are all things, in bringing many adopted sons to glory - To this
very thing, that they are sons, and are treated as such To perfect the
captain - Prince, leader, and author of their salvation, by his atoning
sufferings for them. To perfect or consummate implies the bringing him
to a full and glorious end of all his troubles, chap. v, 9. This
consummation by sufferings intimates,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.iii-p12">1. the glory of Christ, to whom, being
consummated, all things are made subject.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.iii-p13">2. The preceding sufferings. Of these he
treats expressly, ver. 11- 18; having before spoken of his glory, both
to give an edge to his exhortation, and to remove the scandal of
sufferings and death. A fuller consideration of both these points he
interweaves with the following discourse on his priesthood. But what is
here said of our Lord's being made perfect through sufferings, has no
relation to our being saved or sanctified by sufferings. Even he himself
was perfect, as God and as man, before ever be suffered. By his
sufferings, in his life and death, he was made a perfect or complete
sin-offering. But unless we were to be made the same sacrifice, and to
atone for sin, what is said of him in this respect is as much out of our
sphere as his ascension into heaven. It is his atonement, and his Spirit
carrying on "the work of faith with power" in our hearts, that alone can
sanctify us. Various afflictions indeed may be made subservient to this;
and so far as they are blessed to the weaning us from sin, and causing
our affections to be set on things above, so far they do indirectly help
on our sanctification.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p14">11. For - They are nearly related to each other. He that
sanctifieth - Christ, chap. xiii, 12. And all they that are sanctified -
That are brought to God; that draw near or come to him, which are
synonymous terms. Are all of one - Partakers of one nature, from one
parent, Adam.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p15">12. I will declare thy name to my brethren -- Christ
declares the name of God, gracious and merciful, plenteous in goodness
and truth, to all who believe, that they also may praise him. In the
midst of the church will I sing praise unto thee - As the precentor of
the choir. This he did literally, in the midst of his apostles, on the
night before his passion. And as it means, in a more general sense,
setting forth the praise of God, he has done it in the church by his
word and his Spirit; he still does, and will do it throughout all
generations. <scripRef passage="Psalm xxii. 22" id="i.xx.iii-p15.1" parsed="|Ps|22|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.22.22">Psalm xxii,
22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p16">13. And again - As one that has communion with his brethren
in sufferings, as well as in nature, he says, I will put my trust in him
- To carry me through them all. And again - With a like acknowledgment
of his near relation to them, as younger brethren, who were yet but in
their childhood, he presents all believers to God, saying, Behold I and
the children whom thou hast given me. <scripRef passage="Isaiah viii. 17, 18" id="i.xx.iii-p16.1" parsed="|Isa|8|17|8|18" osisRef="Bible:Isa.8.17-Isa.8.18">Isaiah viii, 17,
18</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p17">14. Since then these children partake of flesh and blood -
Of human nature with all its infirmities. He also in like manner took
part of the same; that through his own death he might destroy the
tyranny of him that had, by God's permission, the power of death with
regard to the ungodly. Death is the devil's servant and serjeant,
delivering to him those whom he seizes in sin. That is, the devil - The
power was manifest to all; but who exerted it, they saw not.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p18">15. And deliver them, as many as through fear of death were
all their lifetime, till then, subject to bondage - Every man who fears
death is subject to bondage; is in a slavish, uncomfortable state. And
every man fears death, more or less, who knows not Christ: death is
unwelcome to him, if he knows what death is. But he delivers all true
believers from this bondage.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p19">16. For verily he taketh not hold of angels - He does not
take their nature upon him. But he taketh hold of the seed of Abraham -
He takes human nature upon him. St. Paul says the seed of Abraham,
rather than the seed of Adam, because to Abraham was the promise
made.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p20">17. Wherefore it behoved him - It was highly fit and
proper, yea, necessary, in order to his design of redeeming them. To be
made in all things - That essentially pertain to human nature, and in
all sufferings and temptations. Like his brethren -- this is a
recapitulation of all that goes before: the sum of all that follows is
added immediately. That he might be a merciful and faithful High
Priest-Merciful toward sinners; faithful toward God. A priest or high
priest is one who has a right of approaching God, and of bringing others
to him. Faithful is treated of, chap. iii, 2, &amp;c., with its use;
merciful, chap. iv, 14, &amp;c., with the use also; High Priest, chap.
v, 4, &amp;c., chap. vii, 1, &amp;c. The use is added from chap. x, 19.
In things pertaining to God, to expiate the sins of the people -
Offering up their sacrifices and prayers to God; deriving God's grace,
peace, and blessings upon them.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iii-p21">18. For in that he hath suffered being tempted himself he
is able to succor them that are tempted - That is, he has given a
manifest, demonstrative proof that he is able so to do.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="22.32%" prev="i.xx.iii" next="i.xx.v" id="i.xx.iv">
<h3 id="i.xx.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. III" id="i.xx.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.3" /> 

<p id="i.xx.iv-p1">1. The heavenly calling - God calls from heaven, and to
heaven, by the gospel. Consider the Apostle - The messenger of God, who
pleads the cause of God with us. And High Priest - Who pleads our cause
with God. Both are contained in the one word Mediator. He compares
Christ, as an Apostle, with Moses; as a Priest, with Aaron. Both these
offices, which Moses and Aaron severally bore, he bears together, and
far more eminently. Of our profession - The religion we profess.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p2">2. His house - The church of Israel, then the peculiar
family of God. <scripRef passage="Num. xii. 7" id="i.xx.iv-p2.1" parsed="|Num|12|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.12.7">Num. xii,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p3">3. He that hath builded it hath more glory than the house -
Than the family itself, or any member of it.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p4">4. Now Christ, he that built not only this house, but all
things, is God - And so infinitely greater than Moses or any
creature.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p5">5. And Moses verily - Another proof of the preeminence of
Christ above Moses. Was faithful in all his house, as a servant, for a
testimony of the things which were afterwards to be spoken - That is,
which was a full confirmation of the things which he afterward spake
concerning Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p6">6. But Christ was faithful as a Son; whose house we are,
while we hold fast, and shall be unto the end, if we hold fast our
confidence in God, and glorying in his promises; our faith and hope.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p7">7. Wherefore - Seeing he is faithful, be not ye unfaithful.
<scripRef passage="Psalm xcv. 7" id="i.xx.iv-p7.1" parsed="|Ps|95|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.95.7">Psalm xcv, 7</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p8">8. As in the provocation - When Israel provoked me by their
strife and murmurings. In the day of temptation - When at the same time
they tempted me, by distrusting my power and goodness. <scripRef passage="Exod. xvii. 7" id="i.xx.iv-p8.1" parsed="|Exod|17|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.17.7">Exod. xvii, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p9">9. Where your fathers - That hard-hearted and stiff-necked
generation. So little cause had their descendants to glory in them.
Tempted me - Whether I could and would help them. Proved me - Put my
patience to the proof, even while they saw my glorious works both of
judgment and mercy, and that for forty years.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p10">10. Wherefore - To speak after the manner of men. I was
grieved - Displeased, offended with that generation, and said, They
always err in their hearts - They are led astray by their stubborn will
and vile affections. And - For this reason, because wickedness has
blinded their understanding. They have not known my ways - By which I
would have led them like a flock. Into my rest - In the promised
land.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p11">12. Take heed, lest there be in any of you - As there was
in them. An evil heart of unbelief - Unbelief is the parent of all evil,
and the very essence of unbelief lies in departing from God, as the
living God - The fountain of all our life, holiness, happiness.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p12">13. But, to prevent it, exhort one another, while it is
called Today - This today will not last forever. The day of life will
end soon, and perhaps the day of grace yet sooner.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p13">14. For we are made partakers of Christ - And we shall
still partake of him and all his benefits, if we hold fast our faith
unto the end. If - But not else; and a supposition made by the Holy
Ghost is equal to the, strongest assertion. Both the sentiment and the
manner of expression are the same as ver. 6.</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p14">16. Were they not all that came out of Egypt - An awful
consideration! The whole elect people of God (a very few excepted)
provoked God presently after their great deliverance, continued to
grieve his Spirit for forty years, and perished in their sin!</p>

<p id="i.xx.iv-p15">19. So we see they could not enter in - Though afterward
they desired it.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="22.38%" prev="i.xx.iv" next="i.xx.vi" id="i.xx.v">
<h3 id="i.xx.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. IV" id="i.xx.v-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.4" /> 

<p id="i.xx.v-p1">2. But the word which they heard did not profit them - So
far from it, that it increased their damnation. It is then only when it
is mixed with faith, that it exerts its saving power.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p2">3. For we only that have believed enter into the rest - The
proposition is, There remains a rest for us. This is proved, ver. 3- 11,
thus: That Psalm mentions a rest: yet it does not mean,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.v-p3">1. God's rest from creating; for this was
long before the time of Moses. Therefore in his time another rest was
expected, of which they who then heard fell short Nor is it,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.v-p4">2. The rest which Israel obtained through
Joshua; for the Psalmist wrote after him. Therefore it is,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.v-p5">3. The eternal rest in heaven. As he said -
Clearly showing that there is a farther rest than that which followed
the finishing of the creation. Though the works were finished - Before:
whence it is plain, God did not speak of resting from them.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p6">4. For, long after he had rested from his works, he speaks
again. <scripRef passage="Gen. ii. 2" id="i.xx.v-p6.1" parsed="|Gen|2|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.2.2">Gen. ii, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p7">5. In this psalm, of a rest yet to come.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p8">7. After so long a time - It was above four hundred years
from the time of Moses and Joshua to David. As it was said before - St.
Paul here refers to the text he had just cited.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p9">8. The rest - All the rest which God had promised.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p10">9. Therefore - Since he still speaks of another day, there
must remain a farther, even an eternal, rest for the people of God.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p11">10. For they do not yet so rest. Therefore a fuller rest
remains for them.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p12">11. Lest any one should fall - Into perdition.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p13">12. For the word of God - Preached, ver. 2, and armed with
threatenings, ver. 3. Is living and powerful - Attended with the power
of the living God, and conveying either life or death to the hearers.
Sharper than any two-edged sword - Penetrating the heart more than this
does the body. Piercing - Quite through, and laying open. The soul and
spirit, joints and marrow - The inmost recesses of the mind, which the
apostle beautifully and strongly expresses by this heap of figurative
words. And is a discerner - Not only of the thoughts, but also of the
intentions.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p14">13. In his sight - It is God whose word is thus "powerful:"
it is God in whose sight every creature is manifest; and of this his
word, working on the conscience, gives the fullest conviction. But all
things are naked and opened - Plainly alluding to the sacrifices under
the law which were first flayed, and then (as the Greek word literally
means) cleft asunder through the neck and backbone; so that everything
both without and within was exposed to open view.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p15">14. Having therefore a great high priest - Great indeed,
being the eternal Son of God, that is passed through the heavens - As
the Jewish high priest passed through the veil into the holy of holies,
carrying with him the blood of the sacrifices, on the yearly day of
atonement; so our great high priest went once for all through the
visible heavens, with the virtue of his own blood, into the immediate
presence God.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p16">15. He sympathizes with us even in our innocent
infirmities, wants, weaknesses, miseries, dangers. Yet without sin -
And, therefore, is indisputably able to preserve us from it in all our
temptations.</p>

<p id="i.xx.v-p17">16. Let us therefore come boldly - Without any doubt or
fear. Unto the throne of God, our reconciled Father, even his throne of
grace - Grace erected it, and reigns there, and dispenses all blessings
in a way of mere, unmerited favour.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="22.44%" prev="i.xx.v" next="i.xx.vii" id="i.xx.vi">
<h3 id="i.xx.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. V" id="i.xx.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.5" /> 

<p id="i.xx.vi-p1">1. For every high priest being taken from among men - Is,
till he is taken, of the same rank with them. And is appointed - That
is, is wont to be appointed. In things pertaining to God - To bring God
near to men, and men to God. That he may offer both gifts - Out of
things inanimate, and animal sacrifices.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p2">2. Who can have compassion - In proportion to the offense:
so the Greek word signifies. On the ignorant - Them that are in error.
And the wandering - Them that are in sin. Seeing himself also is
compassed with infirmity - Even with sinful infirmity; and so needs the
compassion which he shows to others.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p3">4. The apostle begins here to treat of the priesthood of
Christ. The sum of what he observes concerning it is, Whatever is
excellent in the Levitical priesthood is in Christ, and in a more
eminent manner; and whatever is wanting in those priests is in him. And
no one taketh this honour - The priesthood. To himself, but he that is
called of God, as was Aaron - And his posterity, who were all of them
called at one and the same time. But it is observable, Aaron did not
preach at all; preaching being no part of the priestly office.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p4">5. So also Christ glorified not himself to be an high
priest - That is, did not take this honour to himself, but received it
from him who said, Thou art my Son, this day have I begotten thee - Not,
indeed, at the same time; for his generation was from eternity. <scripRef passage="Psalm ii. 7" id="i.xx.vi-p4.1" parsed="|Ps|2|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.2.7">Psalm ii, 7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p5">6. <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 4" id="i.xx.vi-p5.1" parsed="|Ps|110|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.4">Psalm cx,
4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p6">7. The sum of the things treated of in the seventh and
following chapters is contained, ver. 7-10; and in this sum is admirably
comprised the process of his passion, with its inmost causes, in the
very terms used by the evangelists. Who in the days of his flesh - Those
two days, in particular, wherein his sufferings were at the height.
Having offered up prayers and supplications - Thrice. With strong crying
and tears - In the garden. To him that was able to save him from death -
Which yet he endured, in obedience to the will of his Father. And being
heard in that which he particularly feared - When the cup was offered
him first, there was set before him that horrible image of a painful,
shameful, accursed death, which moved him to pray conditionally against
it: for, if he had desired it, his heavenly Father would have sent him
more than twelve legions of angels to have delivered him. But what he
most exceedingly feared was the weight of infinite justice; the being
"bruised" and "put to grief" by the hand of God himself. Compared with
this, everything else was a mere nothing; and yet, so greatly did he
ever thirst to be obedient to the righteous will of his Father, and to
"lay down" even "his life for the sheep," that he vehemently longed to
be baptized with this baptism, <scripRef passage="Luke xii. 50" id="i.xx.vi-p6.1" parsed="|Luke|12|50|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.12.50">Luke
xii, 50</scripRef>. Indeed, his human nature needed the support of Omnipotence;
and for this he sent up strong crying and tears: but, throughout his
whole life, he showed that it was not the sufferings he was to undergo,
but the dishonour that sin had done to so holy a God, that grieved his
spotless soul. The consideration of its being the will of God tempered
his fear, and afterwards swallowed it up; and he was heard not so that
the cup should pass away, but so that he drank it without any fear.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p7">8. Though he were a Son - This is interposed. lest any
should be offended at all these instances of human weakness. In the
garden, how frequently did he call God his Father! <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 39" id="i.xx.vi-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|26|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.39">Matt. xxvi, 39</scripRef>, &amp;c. And hence it most evidently appears that his being
the Son of God did not arise merely from his resurrection. Yet learned
he - The word learned, premised to the word suffered, elegantly shows
how willingly he learned. He learned obedience, when be began to suffer;
when he applied himself to drink that cup: obedience in suffering and
dying.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p8">9. And being perfected - By sufferings, chap. ii, 10;
brought through all to glory. He became the author - The procuring and
efficient cause. Of eternal salvation to all that obey him - By doing
and suffering his whole will.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p9">10. Called - The Greek word here properly signifies
surnamed. His name is, "the Son of God." The Holy Ghost seems to have
concealed who Melchisedec was, on purpose that he might be the more
eminent type of Christ. This only we know, - that he was a priest, and
king of Salem, or Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p10">11. Concerning whom - The apostle here begins an important
digression, wherein he reproves, admonishes, and exhorts the Hebrews. We
- Preachers of the gospel. Have many things to say, and hard to be
explained - Though not so much from the subject- matter, as from your
slothfulness in considering, and dulness in apprehending, the things of
God.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p11">12. Ye have need that one teach you again which are the
first principles of religion. Accordingly these are enumerated in the
first verse of the ensuing chapter. And have need of milk - The first
and plainest doctrines.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p12">13. Everyone that useth milk - That neither desires, nor
can digest, anything else: otherwise strong men use milk; but not milk
chiefly, and much less that only. Is unexperienced in the word of
righteousness - The sublimer truths of the gospel. Such are all who
desire and can digest nothing but the doctrine of justification and
imputed righteousness.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vi-p13">14. But strong meat - These sublimer truths relating to
"perfection," chap. vi, 1. Belong to them of full age, who by habit -
Habit here signifies strength of spiritual understanding, arising from
maturity of spiritual age. By, or in consequence of, this habit they
exercise themselves in these things with ease, readiness, cheerfulness,
and profit.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="22.54%" prev="i.xx.vi" next="i.xx.viii" id="i.xx.vii">
<h3 id="i.xx.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. VI" id="i.xx.vii-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.6" /> 

<p id="i.xx.vii-p1">1. Therefore leaving the principles of the doctrine of
Christ - That is, saying no more of them for the present. Let us go on
to perfection; not laying again the foundation of repentance from dead
works - From open sins, the very first thing to be insisted on. And
faith in God - The very next point. So St. Paul in his very first sermon
at Lystra, <scripRef passage="Acts xiv. 15" id="i.xx.vii-p1.1" parsed="|Acts|14|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.14.15">Acts xiv, 15</scripRef>, "Turn from those vanities unto the living God." And when
they believed, they were to be baptized with the baptism, not of the
Jews, or of John, but of Christ. The next thing was, to lay hands upon
them, that they might receive the Holy Ghost: after which they were more
fully instructed, touching the resurrection, and the general judgment;
called eternal, because the sentence then pronounced is irreversible,
and the effects of it remain forever.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p2">3. And this we will do - We will go on to perfection; and
so much the more diligently, because,</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p3">4. It is impossible for those who were once enlightened -
With the light of the glorious love of God in Christ. And have tasted
the heavenly gift - Remission of sins, sweeter than honey and the
honeycomb. And been made partakers of the Holy Ghost - Of the witness
and the fruit of the Spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p4">5. And have tasted the good word of God - Have had a relish
for, and a delight in it. And the powers of the world to come - Which
every one tastes, who has an hope full of immortality. Every child that
is naturally born, first sees the light, then receives and tastes proper
nourishment, and partakes of the things of this world. In like manner,
the apostle, comparing spiritual with natural things, speaks of one born
of the Spirit, as seeing the light, tasting the sweetness, and partaking
of the things "of the world to come."</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p5">6. And have fallen away - Here is not a supposition, but a
plain relation of fact. The apostle here describes the case of those who
have cast away both the power and the form of godliness; who have lost
both their faith, hope, and love, ver. 10, &amp;c., and that wilfully,
chap. x, 26. Of these wilful total apostates he declares, it is
impossible to renew them again to repentance. (though they were renewed
once,) either to the foundation, or anything built thereon. Seeing they
crucify the Son of God afresh - They use him with the utmost indignity.
And put him to an open shame - Causing his glorious name to be
blasphemed.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p6">8. That which beareth thorns and briers - Only or chiefly.
Is rejected - No more labour is bestowed upon it. Whose end is to be
burned - As Jerusalem was shortly after.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p7">9. But, beloved - in this one place he calls them so. he
never uses this appellation, but in exhorting. We are persuaded of you
things that accompany salvation - We are persuaded you are now saved
from your sins; and that ye have that faith, love, and holiness, which
lead to final salvation. Though we thus speak - To warn you, lest you
should fall from your present steadfastness.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p8">10. For - Ye give plain proof of your faith and love, which
the righteous God will surely reward.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p9">11. But we desire you may show the same diligence unto the
end - And therefore we thus speak. To the full assurance of hope - Which
you cannot expect, if you abate your diligence. The full assurance of
faith relates to present pardon; the full assurance of hope, to future
glory. The former is the highest degree of divine evidence that God is
reconciled to me in the Son of his love; the latter is the same degree
of divine evidence (wrought in the soul by the same immediate
inspiration of the Holy Ghost) of persevering grace, and of eternal
glory. So much, and no more, as faith every moment "beholds with open
face," so much does hope see to all eternity But this assurance of faith
and hope is not an opinion, not a bare construction of scripture, but is
given immediately by the power of the Holy Ghost; and what none can have
for another, but for himself only.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p10">12. Inherited the promises - The promised rest;
paradise.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p11">13. For - Ye have abundant encouragement, seeing no
stronger promise could be made than that great promise which God made to
Abraham, and in him to us.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p12">14. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxii. 17" id="i.xx.vii-p12.1" parsed="|Gen|22|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.22.17">Gen. xxii,
17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p13">15. After he had waited - Thirty years. He obtained the
promise - Isaac, the pledge of all the promises.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p14">16. Men generally swear by him who is infinitely greater
than themselves, and an oath for confirmation, to confirm what is
promised or asserted, usually puts an end to all contradiction. This
shows that an oath taken in a religious manner is lawful even under the
gospel: otherwise the apostle would never have mentioned it with so much
honour, as a proper means to confirm the truth</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p15">17. God interposed by an oath - Amazing condescension! He
who is greatest of all acts as if he were a middle person; as if while
he swears, he were less than himself, by whom he swears! Thou that
hearest the promise, dost thou not yet believe?</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p16">18. That by two unchangeable things - His promise and his
oath, in either, much more in both of which, it was impossible for God
to lie, we might have strong consolation - Swallowing up all doubt and
fear. Who have fled - After having been tossed by many storms. To lay
hold on the hope set before us - On Christ, the object of our hope, and
the glory we hope for through him.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p17">19. Which hope in Christ we have as an anchor of the soul -
Entering into heaven itself, and fixed there. Within the veil - Thus he
slides back to the priesthood of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xx.vii-p18">20. A forerunner used to be less in dignity than those that
are to follow him. But it is not so here; for Christ who is gone before
us is infinitely superior to us. What an honour is it to believers, to
have so glorious a forerunner, now appearing in the presence of God for
them.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="22.64%" prev="i.xx.vii" next="i.xx.ix" id="i.xx.viii">
<h3 id="i.xx.viii-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. VII" id="i.xx.viii-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.7" /> 

<p id="i.xx.viii-p1">1. The sum of this chapter is, Christ, as appears from his
type, Melchisedec, who was greater than Abraham himself, from whom Levi
descended, has a priesthood altogether excellent, new, firm, perpetual. <scripRef passage="Gen. xiv. 18" id="i.xx.viii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|14|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.14.18">Gen. xiv, 18</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p2">2. Being first - According to the meaning of his own name.
King of righteousness, then - According to the name of his city. King of
peace - So in him, as in Christ, righteousness and peace were joined.
And so they are in all that believe in him.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p3">3. Without father, without mother, without pedigree -
Recorded, without any account of his descent from any ancestors of the
priestly order. Having neither beginning of days, nor end of life -
Mentioned by Moses. But being - In all these respects. Made like the Son
of God - Who is really without father, as to his human nature; without
mother, as to his divine; and in this also, without pedigree - Neither
descended from any ancestors of the priestly order. Remaineth a priest
continually - Nothing is recorded of the death or successor of
Melchisedec. But Christ alone does really remain without death, and
without successor.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p4">4. The greatness of Melchisedec is described in all the
preceding and following particulars. But the most manifest proof of it
was, that Abraham gave him tithes as to a priest of God and a superior;
though he was himself a patriarch, greater than a king, and a progenitor
of many kings.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p5">5. The sons of Levi take tithes of their brethren -- sprung
from Abraham as well as themselves. The Levites therefore are greater
than they; but the priests are greater than the Levites, the patriarch
Abraham than the priests, and Melchisedec than him.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p6">6. He who is not from them - The Levites Blessed - Another
proof of his superiority. Even him that had the promises - That was so
highly favoured of God. When St. Paul speaks of Christ, he says, "the
promise;" promises refer to other blessings also.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p7">7. The less is blessed - Authoritatively, of the
greater.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p8">8. And here - In the Levitical priesthood. But there - In
the case of Melchisedec. He of whom it is testified that he liveth - Who
is not spoken of as one that died for another to succeed him; but is
represented only as living, no mention being made either of his birth or
death.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p9">9. And even Levi, who received tithes - Not in person, but
in his successors, as it were, paid tithes - In the person of
Abraham.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p10">11. The apostle now demonstrates that the Levitical
priesthood must yield to the priesthood of Christ, because Melchisedec,
after whose order he is a priest,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.viii-p11">1. Is opposed to Aaron, ver. 11-14.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.viii-p12">2. Hath no end of life, ver. 15-19, but
"remaineth a priest continually." If now perfection were by the
Levitical priesthood - If this perfectly answered all God's designs and
man's wants For under it the people received the law - Whence some might
infer, that perfection was by that priesthood. What farther need was
there, that another priest - Of a new order, should be set up? From this
single consideration it is plain, that both the priesthood and the law,
which were inseparably connected, were now to give way to a better
priesthood and more excellent dispensation.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p13">12. For - One of these cannot be changed without the
other.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p14">13. But the priesthood is manifestly changed from one order
to another, and from one tribe to another. For he of whom these things
are spoken - Namely, Jesus. Pertaineth to another tribe - That of Judah.
Of which no man was suffered by the law to attend on, or minister at,
the altar.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p15">14. For it is evident that our Lord sprang out of Judah -
Whatever difficulties have arisen since, during so long a tract of time,
it was then clear beyond dispute.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p16">15. And it is still far more evident, that - Both the
priesthood and the law are changed, because the priest now raised up is
not only of another tribe, but of a quite different order.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p17">16. Who is made - A priest. Not after the law of a carnal
commandment - Not according to the Mosaic law, which consisted chiefly
of commandments that were carnal, compared to the spirituality of the
gospel. But after the power of an endless life - Which he has in
himself, as the eternal Son of God.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p18">18. For there is implied in this new and everlasting
priesthood, and in the new dispensation connected therewith, a
disannulling of the preceding commandment - An abrogation of the Mosaic
law. For the weakness and unprofitableness thereof - For its
insufficiency either to justify or to sanctify.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p19">19. For the law - Taken by itself, separate from the
gospel. Made nothing perfect - Could not perfect its votaries, either in
faith or love, in happiness or holiness. But the bringing in of a better
hope - Of the gospel dispensation, which gives us a better ground of
confidence, does. By which we draw nigh to God - Yea, so nigh as to be
one spirit with him. And this is true perfection.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p20">20. And - The greater solemnity wherewith he was made
priest, farther proves the superior excellency of his priesthood.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p21">21. The Lord swear and will not repent - Hence also it
appears, that his is an unchangeable priesthood.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p22">22. Of so much better a covenant - Unchangeable, eternal.
Was Jesus made a surety - Or mediator. The word covenant frequently
occurs in the remaining part of this epistle. The original word means
either a covenant or a last will and testament. St. Paul takes it
sometimes in the former, sometimes in the latter, sense; sometimes he
includes both.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p23">23. They were many priests - One after another.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p24">24. He continueth forever - In life and in his priesthood.
That passeth not away - To any successor.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p25">25. Wherefore he is able to save to the uttermost - From
all the guilt, power, root, and consequence of sin. Them who come - By
faith. To God through him - As their priest. Seeing he ever liveth to
make intercession - That is, he ever lives and intercedes. He died once;
he intercedes perpetually.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p26">26. For such an high priest suited us - Unholy,
mischievous, defiled sinners: a blessed paradox! Holy - With respect to
God. Harmless - With respect to men. Undefiled - With any sin in
himself. Separated from sinners - As well as free from sin. And so he
was when he left the world. And made - Even in his human nature. Higher
than the heavens - And all their inhabitants.</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p27">27. Who needeth not to offer up sacrifices daily - That is,
on every yearly day of expiation; for he offered once for all: not for
his own sins, for he then offered up himself "without spot to God."</p>

<p id="i.xx.viii-p28">28. The law maketh men high priests that have infirmity -
That are both weak, mortal, and sinful. But the oath which was since the
law - Namely, in the time of David. Maketh the son, who is consecrated
forever - Who being now free, both from sin and death, from natural and
moral infirmity, remaineth a priest forever.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="22.76%" prev="i.xx.viii" next="i.xx.x" id="i.xx.ix">
<h3 id="i.xx.ix-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. VIII" id="i.xx.ix-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.8" /> 

<p id="i.xx.ix-p1">1. We have such an high priest - Having finished his
description of the type in Melchisedec, the apostle begins to treat
directly of the excellency of Christ's priesthood, beyond the Levitical.
Who is set down - Having finished his oblation. At the right hand of the
Majesty - Of God.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p2">2. A minister - Who represents his own sacrifice, as the
high priest did the blood of those sacrifices once a year. Of the
sanctuary - Heaven, typified by the holy of holies. And of the true
tabernacle - Perhaps his human nature, of which the old tabernacle was a
type. Which the Lord hath fixed - Forever. Not man - As Moses fixed the
tabernacle.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p3">4. But if he were on earth - If his priesthood terminated
here. He could not be a priest - At all, consistently with the Jewish
institutions. There being other priests - To whom alone this office is
allotted.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p4">5. Who serve - The temple, which was not yet destroyed.
After the pattern and shadow of heavenly things - Of spiritual,
evangelical worship, and of everlasting glory. The pattern - Somewhat
like the strokes pencilled out upon a piece of fine linen, which exhibit
the figures of leaves and flowers, but have not yet received their
splendid colours and curious shades. And shadow - Or shadowy
representation, which gives you some dim and imperfect idea of the body,
but not the fine features, not the distinguishing air; none of those
living graces which adorn the real person. Yet both the pattern and
shadow lead our minds to something nobler than themselves: the pattern,
to that holiness and glory which complete it; the shadow, to that which
occasions it. <scripRef passage="Exod. xxv. 40" id="i.xx.ix-p4.1" parsed="|Exod|25|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.25.40">Exod. xxv,
40</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p5">6. And now he hath obtained a more excellent ministry - His
priesthood as much excels theirs, as the promises of the gospel (whereof
he is a surety) excels those of the law. These better promises are
specified, ver. 10, xi, those in the law were mostly temporal
promises.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p6">7. For if the first had been faultless - If that
dispensation had answered all God's designs and man's wants, if it had
not been weak and unprofitable unable to make anything perfect, no place
would have been for a second.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p7">8. But there is; for finding fault with them - Who were
under the old covenant he saith, I make a new covenant with the house of
Israel - With all the Israel of God, in all ages and nations. It is new
in many respects, though not as to the substance of it:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.ix-p8">1. Being ratified by the death of Christ.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.ix-p9">2. Freed from those burdensome rites and
ceremonies.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.ix-p10">3. Containing a more full and clear account
of spiritual religion.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.ix-p11">4. Attended with larger influences of the
Spirit</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.ix-p12">5. Extended to all men. And,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.ix-p13">6. Never to be abolished. <scripRef passage="Jer. xxxi. 31" id="i.xx.ix-p13.1" parsed="|Jer|31|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.31.31">Jer. xxxi, 31</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p14">9. When I took them by the hand - With the care and
tenderness of a parent. And just while this was fresh in their memory,
they obeyed; but presently after they shook off the yoke. They continued
not in my covenant, and I regarded them not - So that covenant was soon
broken in pieces.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p15">10. This is the covenant I will make after those days -
After the Mosaic dispensation is abolished. I will put my laws in their
minds - I will open their eyes, and enlighten their understanding, to
see the true, full, spiritual meaning thereof. And write them on their
hearts - So that they shall inwardly experience whatever I have
commanded. And I will be to them a God - Their all- sufficient portion,
and exceeding great reward. And they shall be to me a people - My
treasure, my beloved, loving, and obedient children.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p16">11. And they who are under this covenant (though in other
respects they will have need to teach each other to their lives' end,
yet) shall not need to teach every one his brother, saying, Know the
Lord; for they shall all know me - All real Christians. From the least
to the greatest - In this order the saving knowledge of God ever did and
ever will proceed; not first to the greatest, and then to the least. But
"the Lord shall save the tents," the poorest, "of Judah first, that the
glory of the house of David," the royal seed, "and the glory of the
inhabitants of Jerusalem," the nobles and the rich citizens, "do not
magnify themselves," <scripRef passage="Zech. xii. 7" id="i.xx.ix-p16.1" parsed="|Zech|12|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.12.7">Zech. xii,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p17">12. For I will justify them, which is the root of all true
knowledge of God. This, therefore, is God's method. First, a sinner is
pardoned: then he knows God, as gracious and merciful then God's laws
are written on his heart: he is God's, and God is his.</p>

<p id="i.xx.ix-p18">13. In saying, A new covenant, he hath antiquated the first
- Hath shown that it is disannulled, and out of date. Now that which is
antiquated is ready to vanish away - As it did quickly after, when the
temple was destroyed.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="22.84%" prev="i.xx.ix" next="i.xx.xi" id="i.xx.x">
<h3 id="i.xx.x-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. IX" id="i.xx.x-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9" /> 

<p id="i.xx.x-p1">1. The first covenant had ordinances of outward worship,
and a worldly - a visible, material sanctuary, or tabernacle. Of this
sanctuary he treats, ver. 2-5. Of those ordinances, ver. 6-10.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p2">2. The first - The outward tabernacle. In which was the
candlestick, and the table - The shewbread, shown continually before God
and all the people, consisting of twelve loaves, according to the number
of the tribes, was placed on this table in two rows, six upon one
another in each row. This candlestick and bread seem to have typified
the light and life which are more largely dispensed under the gospel by
Him who is the Light of the world, and the Bread of life.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p3">3. The second veil divided the holy place from the most
holy, as the first veil did the holy place from the courts.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p4">4. Having the golden censer - Used by the high priest only,
on the great day of atonement. And the ark, or chest, of the covenant -
So called from the tables of the covenant contained therein. Wherein was
the manna - The monument of God's care over Israel. And Aaron's rod -
The monument of the regular priesthood. And the tables of the covenant -
The two tables of stone, on which the ten commandments were written by
the finger of God the most venerable monument of all.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p5">5. And over it were the cherubim of glory - Over which the
glory of God used to appear. Some suppose each of these had four faces,
and so represented the Three-One God, with the manhood assumed by the
Second Person. With out-spread wings shadowing the mercy-seat - Which
was a lid or plate of gold, covering the ark.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p6">6. Always - Every day. Accomplishing their services -
Lighting the lamps, changing the shewbread, burning incense, and
sprinkling the blood of the sin offerings.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p7">7. Errors - That is, sins of ignorance, to which only those
atonements extended.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p8">8. The Holy Ghost evidently showing - By this token. That
the way into the holiest - Into heaven. Was not made manifest - Not so
clearly revealed. While the first tabernacle, and its service, were
still subsisting - And remaining in force.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p9">9. Which - Tabernacle, with all its furniture and services.
Is a figure - Or type, of good things to come Which cannot perfect the
worshipper - Neither the priest nor him who brought the offering. As to
his conscience - So that he should be no longer conscious of the guilt
or power of sin. Observe, the temple was as yet standing.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p10">10. They could not so perfect him, with all their train of
precepts relating to meats and drinks, and carnal, gross, external
ordinances; and were therefore imposed only till the time of reformation
- Till Christ came.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p11">11. An high priest of good things to come - Described, ver.
15. Entered through a greater, that is, a more noble, and perfect
tabernacle - Namely, his own body. Not of this creation - Not framed by
man, as that tabernacle was.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p12">12. The holy place - Heaven. For us - All that believe.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p13">13. If the ashes of an heifer - Consumed by fire as a
sin-offering, being sprinkled on them who were legally unclean. Purified
the flesh - Removed that legal uncleanness, and re-admitted them to the
temple and the congregation. <scripRef passage="Num. xix. 17, 18, 19" id="i.xx.x-p13.1" parsed="|Num|19|17|19|19" osisRef="Bible:Num.19.17-Num.19.19">Num. xix, 17, 18, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p14">14. How much more shall the blood of Christ. - The merit of
all his sufferings. Who through the eternal Spirit - The work of
redemption being the work of the whole Trinity. Neither is the Second
Person alone concerned even in the amazing condescension that was
needful to complete it. The Father delivers up the kingdom to the Son;
and the Holy Ghost becomes the gift of the Messiah, being, as it were,
sent according to his good pleasure. Offered himself - Infinitely more
precious than any created victim, and that without spot to God. Purge
our conscience - Our inmost soul. From dead works - From all the inward
and outward works of the devil, which spring from spiritual death in the
soul, and lead to death everlasting. To serve the living God - In the
life of faith, in perfect love and spotless holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p15">15. And for this end he is the Mediator of a new covenant,
that they who are called - To the engagements and benefits thereof.
Might receive the eternal inheritance promised to Abraham: not by means
of legal sacrifices, but of his meritorious death. For the redemption of
the transgressions that were under the first covenant - That is, for the
redemption of transgressors from the guilt and punishment of those sins
which were committed in the time of the old covenant. The article of his
death properly divides the old covenant from the new.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p16">16. I say by means of death; for where such a covenant is,
there must be the death of him by whom it is confirmed - Seeing it is by
his death that the benefits of it are purchased. It seems beneath the
dignity of the apostle to play upon the ambiguity of the Greek word, as
the common translation supposes him to do.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p17">17. After he is dead - Neither this, nor after men are dead
is a literal translation of the words. It is a very perplexed
passage.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p18">18. Whence neither was the first - The Jewish covenant,
originally transacted without the blood of an appointed sacrifice.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p19">19. He took the blood of calves - Or heifers. And of goats,
with water, and scarlet wool, and hyssop - All these circumstances are
not particularly mentioned in that chapter of Exodus, but are supposed
to be already known from other passages of Moses. And the book itself -
Which contained all he had said. And sprinkled all the people - Who were
near him. The blood was mixed with water to prevent its growing too
stiff for sprinkling; perhaps also to typify that blood and water, <scripRef passage="John xix. 34" id="i.xx.x-p19.1" parsed="|John|19|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.34">John xix, 34</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiv. 7, 8" id="i.xx.x-p19.2" parsed="|Exod|24|7|24|8" osisRef="Bible:Exod.24.7-Exod.24.8">Exod. xxiv, 7, 8</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p20">20. Saying, This is the blood of the covenant which God
hath enjoined me to deliver unto you - By this it is established. <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiv. 8" id="i.xx.x-p20.1" parsed="|Exod|24|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.24.8">Exod. xxiv, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p21">21. And in like manner he ordered the tabernacle - When it
was made, and all its vessels, to be sprinkled with blood once a
year.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p22">22. And almost all things - For some were purified by water
or fire. Are according to the law purified with blood - Offered or
sprinkled. And according to the law, there is no forgiveness of sins
without shedding of blood - All this pointed to the blood of Christ
effectually cleansing from all sin, and intimated, there can be no
purification from it by any other means.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p23">23. Therefore - That is, it plainly appears from what has
been said. It was necessary - According to the appointment of God. That
the tabernacle and all its utensils, which were patterns, shadowy
representations, of things in heaven, should be purified by these -
Sacrifices and sprinklings. But the heavenly things themselves - Our
heaven-born spirits: what more this may mean we know not yet. By better
sacrifices than these - That is, by a better sacrifice, which is here
opposed to all the legal sacrifices, and is expressed plurally, because
it includes the signification of them all, and is of so much more
eminent virtue.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p24">24. For Christ did not enter into the holy place made with
hands - He never went into the holy of holies at Jerusalem, the figure
of the true tabernacle in heaven, chap. viii, 2. But into heaven itself,
to appear in the presence of God for us - As our glorious high priest
and powerful intercessor.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p25">26. For then he must often have suffered from the
foundation of the world - This supposes,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.x-p26">1. That by suffering once he atoned for all
the sins which had been committed from the foundation of the world.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.x-p27">2. That he could not have atoned for them
without suffering. At the consummation of the ages - The sacrifice of
Christ divides the whole age or duration of the world into two parts,
and extends its virtue backward and forward, from this middle point
wherein they meet to abolish both the guilt and power of sin.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p28">27. After this, the judgment - Of the great day. At the
moment of death every man's final state is determined. But there is not
a word in scripture of a particular judgment immediately after
death.</p>

<p id="i.xx.x-p29">28. Christ having once died to bear the sins - The
punishment due to them. Of many - Even as many as are born into the
world. Will appear the second time - When he comes to judgment. Without
sin - Not as he did before, bearing on himself the sins of many, but to
bestow everlasting salvation.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="22.99%" prev="i.xx.x" next="i.xx.xii" id="i.xx.xi">
<h3 id="i.xx.xi-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. X" id="i.xx.xi-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.10" /> 

<p id="i.xx.xi-p1">1. From all that has been said it appears, that the law,
the Mosaic dispensation, being a bare, unsubstantial shadow of good
things to come, of the gospel blessings, and not the substantial, solid
image of them, can never with the same kind of sacrifices, though
continually repeated, make the comers thereunto perfect, either as to
justification or sanctification. How is it possible, that any who
consider this should suppose the attainments of David, or any who were
under that dispensation, to be the proper measure of gospel holiness;
and that Christian experience is to rise no higher than Jewish?</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p2">2. They who had been once perfectly purged, would have been
no longer conscious either of the guilt or power of their sins.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p3">3. There is a public commemoration of the sins both of the
last and of all the preceding years; a clear proof that the guilt
thereof is not perfectly purged away.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p4">4. It is impossible the blood of goats should take away
sins - Either the guilt or the power of them.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p5">5. When he cometh into the world - In the fortieth Psalm
the Messiah's coming into the world is represented. It is said, into the
world, not into the tabernacle, chap. ix, 1; because all the world is
interested in his sacrifice. A body hast thou prepared for me - That I
may offer up myself. <scripRef passage="Psalm xl. 6" id="i.xx.xi-p5.1" parsed="|Ps|40|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.40.6">Psalm xl,
6</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p6">7. In the volume of the book - In this very psalm it is
written of me. Accordingly I come to do thy will - By the sacrifice of
myself.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p7">8. Above when he said, Sacrifice thou hast not chosen -
That is, when the Psalmist pronounced those words in his name.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p8">9. Then said he - in that very instant he subjoined. Lo, I
come to do Thy will - To offer a more acceptable sacrifice; and by this
very act he taketh away the legal, that he may establish the
evangelical, dispensation.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p9">10. By which will - Of God, done and suffered by Christ. We
are sanctified - Cleansed from guilt, and consecrated to God.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p10">11. Every priest standeth - As a servant in an humble
posture.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p11">12. But he - The virtue of whose one sacrifice remains for
ever. Sat down - As a son, in majesty and honour.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p12">13. <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 1" id="i.xx.xi-p12.1" parsed="|Ps|110|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.1">Psalm cx,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p13">14. He hath perfected them forever - That is, has done all
that was needful in order to their full reconciliation with God.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p14">15. In this and the three following verses, the apostle
winds up his argument concerning the excellency and perfection of the
priesthood and sacrifice of Christ. He had proved this before by a
quotation from Jeremiah; which he here repeats, describing the new
covenant as now completely ratified, and all the blessings of it secured
to us by the one offering of Christ, which renders all other expiatory
sacrifices, and any repetition of his own, utterly needless.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p15">16. <scripRef passage="Jer. xxxi. 33" id="i.xx.xi-p15.1" parsed="|Jer|31|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.31.33">Jer. xxxi,
33</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p16">19. Having finished the doctrinal part of his epistle, the
apostle now proceeds to exhortation deduced from what has been treated
of chap. v, 4, which he begins by a brief recapitulation. Having
therefore liberty to enter,</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p17">20. By a living way - The way of faith, whereby we live
indeed. Which he hath consecrated - Prepared, dedicated, and established
for us. Through the veil, that is, his flesh - As by rending the veil in
the temple, the holy of holies became visible and accessible; so by
wounding the body of Christ, the God of heaven was manifested, and the
way to heaven opened.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p18">22. Let us draw near - To God. With a true heart - In godly
sincerity. Having our hearts sprinkled from an evil conscience - So as
to condemn us no longer And our bodies washed with pure water - All our
conversation spotless and holy, which is far more acceptable to God than
all the legal sprinklings and washings.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p19">23. The profession of our hope - The hope which we
professed at our baptism.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p20">25. Not forsaking the assembling ourselves - In public or
private worship. As the manner of some is - Either through fear of
persecution, or from a vain imagination that they were above external
ordinances. But exhorting one another - To faith, love, and good works.
And so much the more, as ye see the day approaching - The great day is
ever in your eye.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p21">26. For when we - Any of us Christians. Sin wilfully - By
total apostasy from God, termed "drawing back," ver. 38. After having
received the experimental knowledge of the gospel truth, there remaineth
no more sacrifice for sins - None but that which we obstinately
reject.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p22">28. He that, in capital cases, despised (presumptuously
transgressed) the law of Moses died without mercy - Without any delay or
mitigation of his punishment.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p23">29. Of how much sorer punishment is he worthy, who - By
wilful, total apostasy. It does not appear that this passage refers to
any other sin. Hath, as it were, trodden underfoot the Son of God - A
lawgiver far more honourable than Moses. And counted the blood wherewith
the better covenant was established, an unholy, a common, worthless
thing. By which he hath been sanctified - Therefore Christ died for him
also, and he was at least justified once. And done despite to the Spirit
of grace - By rejecting all his motions.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p24">30. The Lord will judge his people - Yea, far more
rigorously than the heathens, if they rebel against him. <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 35" id="i.xx.xi-p24.1" parsed="|Deut|32|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.35">Deut. xxxii, 35</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p25">31. To fall into the hands - Of his avenging justice.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p26">32. Enlightened - With the knowledge of God and of his
truth.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p27">34. For ye sympathized with all your suffering brethren,
and with me in particular; and received joyfully the loss of your own
goods.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p28">35. Cast not away therefore this your confidence - Your
faith and hope; which none can deprive you of but yourselves.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p29">36. The promise - Perfect love; eternal life.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p30">37. He that cometh - To reward every man according to his
works.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p31">38. Now the just - The justified person. Shall live - In
God's favour, a spiritual and holy life. By faith - As long as he
retains that gift of God. But if he draw back - If he make shipwreck of
his faith My soul hath no pleasure in him - That is, I abhor him; I cast
him off. <scripRef passage="Hab. ii. 3" id="i.xx.xi-p31.1" parsed="|Hab|2|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hab.2.3">Hab. ii, 3</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xi-p32">39. We are not of them who draw back to perdition - Like
him mentioned ver. 38. But of them that believe - To the end, so as to
attain eternal life.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="23.09%" prev="i.xx.xi" next="i.xx.xiii" id="i.xx.xii">
<h3 id="i.xx.xii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. XI" id="i.xx.xii-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11" /> 

<p id="i.xx.xii-p1">1. The definition of faith given in this verse, and
exemplified in the various instances following, undoubtedly includes
justifying faith, but not directly as justifying. For faith justifies
only as it refers to, and depends on, Christ. But here is no mention of
him as the object of faith; and in several of the instances that follow,
no notice is taken of him or his salvation, but only of temporal
blessings obtained by faith. And yet they may all be considered as
evidences of the power of justifying faith in Christ, and of its
extensive exercise in a course of steady obedience amidst difficulties
and dangers of every kind. Now faith is the subsistence of things hoped
for, the evidence or conviction of things not seen - Things hoped for
are not so extensive as things not seen. The former are only things
future and joyful to us; the latter are either future, past, or present,
and those either good or evil, whether to us or others. The subsistence
of things hoped for - Giving a kind of present subsistence to the good
things which God has promised: the divine supernatural evidence
exhibited to, the conviction hereby produced in, a believer of things
not seen, whether past, future, or spiritual; particularly of God and
the things of God.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p2">2. By it the elders - Our forefathers. This chapter is a
kind of summary of the Old Testament, in which the apostle comprises the
designs, labours, sojournings, expectations, temptations, martyrdoms of
the ancients. The former of them had a long exercise of their patience;
the latter suffered shorter but sharper trials. Obtained a good
testimony - A most comprehensive word. God gave a testimony, not only of
them but to them: and they received his testimony as if it had been the
things themselves of which he testified, ver. 4, 5, 39. Hence they also
gave testimony to others, and others testified of them.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p3">3. By faith we understand that the worlds - Heaven and
earth and all things in them, visible and invisible. Where made -
Formed, fashioned, and finished. By the word - The sole command of God,
without any instrument or preceding matter. And as creation is the
foundation and specimen of the whole divine economy, so faith in the
creation is the foundation and specimen of all faith. So that things
which are seen - As the sun, earth, stars. Were made of things which do
not appear - Out of the dark, unapparent chaos, <scripRef passage="Gen. i. 2" id="i.xx.xii-p3.1" parsed="|Gen|1|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.1.2">Gen. i, 2</scripRef>. And this very chaos was created by the divine power; for
before it was thus created it had no existence in nature.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p4">4. By faith - In the future Redeemer. Abel offered a more
excellent sacrifice - The firstlings of his flock, implying both a
confession of what his own sins deserved, and a desire of sharing in the
great atonement. Than Cain - Whose offering testified no such faith, but
a bare acknowledgment of God the Creator. By which faith he obtained
both righteousness and a testimony of it: God testifying - Visibly that
his gifts were accepted; probably by sending fire from heaven to consume
his sacrifice, a token that justice seized on the sacrifice instead of
the sinner who offered it. And by it - By this faith. Being dead, he yet
speaketh - That a sinner is accepted only through faith in the great
sacrifice.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p5">5. Enoch was not any longer found among men, though perhaps
they sought for him as they did for Elijah, <scripRef passage="2 Kings ii. 17" id="i.xx.xii-p5.1" parsed="|2Kgs|2|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.2.17">2 Kings ii, 17</scripRef>. He had this testimony - From God in his own conscience.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p6">6. But without faith - Even some divine faith in God, it is
impossible to please him. For he that cometh to God - in prayer, or
another act of worship, must believe that he is.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p7">7. Noah being warned of things not seen as yet - Of the
future deluge. Moved with fear, prepared an ark, by which open testimony
he condemned the world - Who neither believed nor feared.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p8">8. <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 1-4" id="i.xx.xii-p8.1" parsed="|Gen|12|1|12|4" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.1-Gen.12.4">Gen. xii,
1-4</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p9">9. By faith he sojourned in the land of promise - The
promise was made before, <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 7" id="i.xx.xii-p9.1" parsed="|Gen|12|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.7">Gen. xii,
7</scripRef>. Dwelling in tents - As a sojourner With Isaac and Jacob -
Who by the same manner of living showed the same faith Jacob was born
fifteen years before the death of Abraham. The joint heirs of the same
promise - Having all the same interest therein. Isaac did not receive
this inheritance from Abraham, nor Jacob from Isaac, but all of them
from God. <scripRef passage="Gen. xvii. 8" id="i.xx.xii-p9.2" parsed="|Gen|17|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.17.8">Gen. xvii, 8</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p10">10. He looked for a city which hath foundations - Whereas a
tent has none. Whose builder and former is God - Of which God is the
sole contriver, former, and finisher.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p11">11. Sarah also herself - Though at first she laughed at the
promise, <scripRef passage="Gen. xviii. 12" id="i.xx.xii-p11.1" parsed="|Gen|18|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.18.12">Gen. xviii, 12</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxi. 2" id="i.xx.xii-p11.2" parsed="|Gen|21|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.21.2">Gen. xxi, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p12">12. As it were dead - Till his strength was supernaturally
restored, which continued for many years after.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p13">13. All these - Mentioned ver. 7-11. Died in faith - In
death faith acts most vigourously. Not having received the promises -
The promised blessings. Embraced - As one does a dear friend when he
meets him.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p14">14. They who speak thus show plainly that they seek their
own country - That they keep in view, and long for, their native
home.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p15">15. If they had been mindful of - Their earthly country, Ur
of the Chaldeans, they might have easily returned.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p16">16. But they desire a better country, that is, an heavenly
- This is a full convincing proof that the patriarchs had a Revelation
and a promise of eternal glory in heaven. Therefore God is not ashamed
to be called their God: seeing he hath prepared for them a city - Worthy
of God to give.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p17">17. By faith Abraham - When God made that glorious trial of
him. Offered up Isaac - The will being accepted as if he had actually
done it. Yea, he that had received the promises - Particularly that
grand promise, "In Isaac shall thy seed be called." Offered up - This
very son; the only one he had by Sarah. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxii. 1" id="i.xx.xii-p17.1" parsed="|Gen|22|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.22.1">Gen. xxii, 1</scripRef>,&amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p18">18. In Isaac shall thy seed be called - From him shall the
blessed seed spring. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxi. 12" id="i.xx.xii-p18.1" parsed="|Gen|21|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.21.12">Gen. xxi,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p19">19. Accounting that God was able even to raise him from the
dead - Though there had not been any instance of this in the world. From
whence also - To speak in a figurative way. He did receive him -
Afterwards, snatched from the jaws of death.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p20">20. Blessed - <scripRef passage="Gen. xxvii. 27, 39" id="i.xx.xii-p20.1" parsed="|Gen|27|27|0|0;|Gen|27|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.27.27 Bible:Gen.27.39">Gen.
xxvii, 27, 39</scripRef>; prophetically foretold the particular blessings they should
partake of. Jacob and Esau - Preferring the elder before the
younger.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p21">21. Jacob when dying - That is, when near death. Bowing
down on the top of his staff - As he sat on the side of his bed. <scripRef passage="Gen. xlviii. 16" id="i.xx.xii-p21.1" parsed="|Gen|48|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.48.16">Gen. xlviii, 16</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Gen. xlvii. 31" id="i.xx.xii-p21.2" parsed="|Gen|47|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.47.31">Gen. xlvii, 31</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p22">22. Concerning his bones - To be carried into the land of
promise.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p23">23. They saw - Doubtless with a divine presage of things to
come.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p24">24. Refused to be called - Any longer.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p25">26. The reproach of Christ - That which he bore for
believing in the Messiah to come, and acting accordingly. For he looked
off - From all those perishing treasures, and beyond all those temporal
hardships Unto the recompence of reward - Not to an inheritance in
Canaan; he had no warrant from God to look for this, nor did he ever
attain it; but what his believing ancestors looked for, - a future state
of happiness in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p26">27. By faith he left Egypt - Taking all the Israelites with
him. Not then fearing the wrath of the king - As he did many years
before, <scripRef passage="Exod. ii. 14" id="i.xx.xii-p26.1" parsed="|Exod|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.2.14">Exod. ii, 14</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Exod. xiv. 15" id="i.xx.xii-p26.2" parsed="|Exod|14|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.14.15">Exod. xiv, 15</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p27">28. The pouring out of the blood - Of the paschal lamb,
which was sprinkled on the door-posts, lest the destroying angel should
touch the Israelites. <scripRef passage="Exod. xii. 12-18" id="i.xx.xii-p27.1" parsed="|Exod|12|12|12|18" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12.12-Exod.12.18">Exod. xii,
12-18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p28">29. They - Moses, Aaron, and the Israelites. Passed the Red
Sea - It washed the borders of Edom, which signifies red. Thus far the
examples are cited from Genesis and Exodus; those that follow are from
the former and the latter Prophets.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p29">30. By the faith of Joshua.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p30">31. Rahab - Though formerly one not of the fairest
character.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p31">32. After Samuel, the prophets are properly mentioned.
David also was a prophet; but he was a king too. The prophets - Elijah,
Elisha, &amp;c., including likewise the believers who lived with
them.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p32">33, 34. David, in particular, subdued kingdoms. Samuel (not
excluding the rest) wrought righteousness. The prophets, in general,
obtained promises, both for themselves, and to deliver to others.
Prophets also stopped the mouths of lions, as Daniel; and quenched the
violence of fire, as Shadrach, Meshach, and Abednego. To these examples,
whence the nature of faith clearly appears, those more ancient ones are
subjoined, (by a transposition, and in an inverted order,) which receive
light from these. Jephthah escaped the edge of the sword; Samson out of
weakness was made strong; Barak became valiant in fight; Gideon put to
flight armies of the aliens. Faith animates to the most heroic
enterprises, both civil and military. Faith overcomes all impediments
effects the greatest things; attains to the very best; and inverts, by
its miraculous power the very course of nature. <scripRef passage="2 Sam. viii. 1" id="i.xx.xii-p32.1" parsed="|2Sam|8|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.8.1">2 Sam. viii, 1</scripRef>,&amp;c.; <scripRef passage="1 Sam. viii. 9" id="i.xx.xii-p32.2" parsed="|1Sam|8|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.8.9">1 Sam. viii, 9</scripRef>,&amp;c.; <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xiii. 3" id="i.xx.xii-p32.3" parsed="|1Sam|13|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.13.3">1 Sam. xiii, 3</scripRef>,&amp;c.; <scripRef passage="Dan. vi. 22" id="i.xx.xii-p32.4" parsed="|Dan|6|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.6.22">Dan. vi, 22</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Dan. iii. 27" id="i.xx.xii-p32.5" parsed="|Dan|3|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.3.27">Dan. iii,
27</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Jude xii. 3" id="i.xx.xii-p32.6" parsed="|Jude|12|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.12.3">Jude xii, 3</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Jude xv. 19" id="i.xx.xii-p32.7" parsed="|Jude|15|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.15.19">Jude xv, 19</scripRef>,&amp;c.; <scripRef passage="Jude xvi. 28" id="i.xx.xii-p32.8" parsed="|Jude|16|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.16.28">Jude xvi, 28</scripRef>,&amp;c.; <scripRef passage="Jude iv. 14" id="i.xx.xii-p32.9" parsed="|Jude|4|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.4.14">Jude iv, 14</scripRef>,&amp;c.; <scripRef passage="Jude vii. 21" id="i.xx.xii-p32.10" parsed="|Jude|7|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.7.21">Jude vii, 21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p33">35. Women - Naturally weak. Received their dead - Children.
Others were tortured - From those who acted great things the apostle
rises higher, to those who showed the power of faith by suffering. Not
accepting deliverance - On sinful terms. That they might obtain a better
resurrection - An higher reward, seeing the greater their sufferings the
greater would be their glory. <scripRef passage="1 Kings xvii. 22" id="i.xx.xii-p33.1" parsed="|1Kgs|17|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.17.22">1 Kings xvii, 22</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="2 Kings iv. 35" id="i.xx.xii-p33.2" parsed="|2Kgs|4|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.4.35">2 Kings iv, 35</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p34">36. And others - The apostle seems here to pass on to
recent examples.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p35">37. They were sawn asunder - As, according to the tradition
of the Jews, Isaiah was by Manasseh. Were tempted - Torments and death
are mentioned alternately. Every way; by threatenings, reproaches,
tortures, the variety of which cannot be expressed; and again by
promises and allurements.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p36">38. Of whom the world was not worthy - It did not deserve
so great a blessing. They wandered - Being driven out from men.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p37">39. And all these - Though they obtained a good testimony,
ver. 2, yet did not receive the great promise, the heavenly
inheritance.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xii-p38">40. God having provided some better thing for us - Namely,
everlasting glory. That they might not be perfected without us - That
is, that we might all be perfected together in heaven.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="23.27%" prev="i.xx.xii" next="i.xx.xiv" id="i.xx.xiii">
<h3 id="i.xx.xiii-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. XII" id="i.xx.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.12" /> 

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p1">1. Wherefore, being encompassed with a cloud - A great
multitude, tending upward with a holy swiftness. Of witnesses - Of the
power of faith. Let us lay aside every weight - As all who run a race
take care to do. Let us throw off whatever weighs us down, or damps the
vigour of our Soul. And the sin which easily besetteth us - As doth the
sin of our constitution, the sin of our education, the sin of our
profession.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p2">2. Looking - From all other things. To Jesus - As the
wounded Israelites to the brazen serpent. Our crucified Lord was
prefigured by the lifting up of this; our guilt, by the stings of the
fiery serpents; and our faith, by their looking up to the miraculous
remedy. The author and finisher of our faith - Who begins it in us,
carries it on, and perfects it. Who for the joy that was set before him
- Patiently and willingly endured the cross, with all the pains annexed
thereto. And is set down - Where there is fulness of joy.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p3">3. Consider - Draw the comparison and think. The Lord bore
all this; and shall his servants bear nothing? Him that endured such
contradiction from sinners - Such enmity and opposition of every kind
Lest ye be weary - Dull and languid, and so actually faint in your
course.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p4">4. Unto blood - Unto wounds and death.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p5">5. And yet ye seem already to have forgotten the
exhortation - Wherein God speaketh to you with the utmost tenderness.
Despise not thou the chastening of the Lord - Do not slight or make
little of it; do not impute any affliction to chance or second causes
but see and revere the hand of God in it. Neither faint when thou art
rebuked of him - But endure it patiently and fruitfully. <scripRef passage="Pro iii. 11" id="i.xx.xiii-p5.1" parsed="|Prov|3|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.3.11">Pro iii, 11</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p6">6. For - All springs from love; therefore neither despise
nor faint.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p7">7. Whom his father chasteneth not - When he offends.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p8">8. Of which all sons are partakers - More or less.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p9">9. And we reverenced them - We neither despised nor fainted
under their correction. Shall we not much rather - Submit with reverence
and meekness To the Father of spirits - That we may live with him for
ever. Perhaps these expressions, fathers of our flesh, and Father of
spirits, intimate that our earthly fathers are only the parents of our
bodies, our souls not being originally derived from them, but all
created by the immediate power of God; perhaps, at the beginning of the
world.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p10">10. For they verily for a few days - How few are even all
our day on earth! Chastened us as they thought good - Though frequently
they erred therein, by too much either of indulgence or severity. But he
always, unquestionably, for our profit, that we may be partakers of his
holiness - That is, of himself and his glorious image.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p11">11. Now all chastening - Whether from our earthly or
heavenly Father, Is for the present grievous, yet it yieldeth the
peaceable fruit of righteousness - Holiness and happiness. To them that
are exercised thereby - That receive this exercise as from God, and
improve it according to his will.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p12">12. Wherefore lift up the hands - Whether your own or your
brethren's. That hang down - Unable to continue the combat. And the
feeble knees - Unable to continue the race. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxxv. 3" id="i.xx.xiii-p12.1" parsed="|Isa|35|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.35.3">Isaiah xxxv, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p13">13. And make straight paths both for your own and for their
feet - Remove every hindrance, every offense. That the lame - They who
are weak, scarce able to walk. Be not turned out of the way - Of faith
and holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p14">14. Follow peace with all men - This second branch of the
exhortation concerns our neighbours; the third, God. And holiness - The
not following after all holiness, is the direct way to fall into sin of
every kind.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p15">15. Looking diligently, lest any one - If he do not lift up
the hands that hang down. Fall from the grace of God: lest any root of
bitterness - Of envy, anger, suspicion. Springing up - Destroy the sweet
peace; lest any, not following after holiness, fall into fornication or
profaneness. In general, any corruption, either in doctrine or practice,
is a root of bitterness, and may pollute many.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p16">16. Esau was profane for so slighting the blessing which
went along with the birth-right.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p17">17. He was rejected - He could not obtain it. For he found
no place for repentance - There was no room for any such repentance as
would regain what he had lost. Though he sought it - The blessing of the
birth-right. Diligently with tears - He sought too late. Let us use the
present time.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p18">18. For - A strong reason this why they ought the more to
regard the whole exhortation drawn from the priesthood of Christ:
because both salvation and vengeance are now nearer at hand. Ye are not
come to the mountain that could be touched - That was of an earthy,
material nature.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p19">19. The sound of a trumpet - Formed, without doubt, by the
ministry of angels, and preparatory to the words, that is, the Ten
Commandments, which were uttered with a loud voice, <scripRef passage="Deut. v. 22" id="i.xx.xiii-p19.1" parsed="|Deut|5|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.5.22">Deut. v, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p20">20. For they could not bear - The terror which seized them,
when they heard those words proclaimed, If even a beast, &amp;c. <scripRef passage="Exod. xix. 12" id="i.xx.xiii-p20.1" parsed="|Exod|19|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.19.12">Exod. xix, 12</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p21">21. Even Moses - Though admitted to so near an intercourse
with God, who "spake to him as a man speaketh to his friend." At other
times he acted as a mediator between God and the people. But while the
ten words were pronounced, he stood as one of the hearers, <scripRef passage="Exod. xix. 25" id="i.xx.xiii-p21.1" parsed="|Exod|19|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.19.25">Exod. xix, 25</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 19" id="i.xx.xiii-p21.2" parsed="|Exod|20|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.19">Exod. xx, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p22">22. But ye - Who believe in Christ. Are come - The apostle
does not here speak of their coming to the church militant, but of that
glorious privilege of New Testament believers, their communion with the
church triumphant. But this is far more apparent to the eyes of
celestial spirits than to ours which are yet veiled. St. Paul here shows
an excellent knowledge of the heavenly economy, worthy of him who had
been caught up into the third heaven. To Mount Zion--A spiritual
mountain. To the city of the living God, the heavenly Jerusalem - All
these glorious titles belong to the New Testament church. And to an
innumerable company - Including all that are afterwards mentioned.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p23">23. To the general assembly - The word properly signifies a
stated convention on some festival occasion. And church - The whole body
of true believers, whether on earth or in paradise. Of the
first-born-The first-born of Israel were enrolled by Moses; but these
are enrolled in heaven, as citizens there. It is observable, that in
this beautiful gradation, these first-born are placed nearer to God than
the angels. See <scripRef passage="Jam i. 18" id="i.xx.xiii-p23.1" parsed="|Jas|1|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.1.18">Jam i, 18</scripRef>. And to God the Judge of all - Propitious to you, adverse to
your enemies. And to the spirits - The separate souls. Of just men - It
seems to mean, of New Testament believers. The number of these, being
not yet large, is mentioned distinct from the innumerable company of
just men whom their Judge hath acquitted. These are now made perfect in
an higher sense than any who are still alive. Accordingly, St. Paul,
while yet on earth, denies that he was thus made perfect, <scripRef passage="Phil. iii. 12" id="i.xx.xiii-p23.2" parsed="|Phil|3|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Phil.3.12">Phil. iii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p24">24. To Jesus, the mediator - Through whom they had been
perfected. And to the blood of sprinkling - To all the virtue of his
precious blood shed for you, whereby ye are sprinkled from an evil
conscience. This blood of sprinkling was the foundation of our Lord's
mediatorial office. Here the gradation is at the highest point. Which
speaketh better things than that of Abel - Which cried for
vengeance.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p25">25. Refuse not - By unbelief. Him that speaketh - And whose
speaking even now is a prelude to the final scene. The same voice which
spake both by the law and in the gospel, when heard from heaven, will
shake heaven and earth. For if they escaped not - His vengeance. Much
more shall not we - Those of us who turn from him that speaketh from
heaven - That is, who came from heaven to speak to us.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p26">26. Whose voice then shook the earth - When he spoke from
Mount Sinai. But now - With regard to his next speaking. He hath
promised - It is a joyful promise to the saints, though dreadful to the
wicked. Yet once more I will shake, not only the earth, but also the
heaven - These words may refer in a lower sense to the dissolution of
the Jewish church and state; but in their full sense they undoubtedly
look much farther, even to the end of all things. This universal shaking
began at the first coming of Christ. It will be consummated at his
second coming. <scripRef passage="Hag. ii. 6" id="i.xx.xiii-p26.1" parsed="|Hag|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hag.2.6">Haggai ii,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p27">27. The things which are shaken - Namely, heaven and earth.
As being made - And consequently liable to change. That the things which
are not shaken may remain - Even "the new heavens and the new earth," <scripRef passage="Rev. xxi. 1" id="i.xx.xiii-p27.1" parsed="|Rev|21|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.21.1">Rev. xxi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p28">28. Therefore let us, receiving - By willing and joyful
faith. A kingdom - More glorious than the present heaven and earth. Hold
fast the grace, whereby we may serve God - In every thought, word, and
work. With reverence - Literally, with shame. Arising from a deep
consciousness of our own unworthiness. And godly fear - A tender,
jealous fear of offending, arising from a sense of the gracious majesty
of God.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiii-p29">29. For our God is a consuming fire - in the strictness of
his justice, and purity of his holiness.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="23.43%" prev="i.xx.xiii" next="i.xxi" id="i.xx.xiv">
<h3 id="i.xx.xiv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Heb. XIII" id="i.xx.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|Heb|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.13" /> 

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p1">1. Brotherly love is explained in the following verses.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p2">2. Some - Abraham and Lot. Have entertained angels unawares
- So may an unknown guest, even now, be of more worth than he appears,
and may have angels attending him, though unseen. <scripRef passage="Gen. xviii. 2" id="i.xx.xiv-p2.1" parsed="|Gen|18|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.18.2">Gen. xviii, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Gen. xix. 1" id="i.xx.xiv-p2.2" parsed="|Gen|19|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.19.1">Gen.
xix, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p3">3. Remember - In your prayers, and by your help. Them that
are in bonds, as being bound with them - Seeing ye are members one of
another. And them that suffer, as being yourselves in the body - And
consequently liable to the same.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p4">4. Marriage is honourable in, or for all sorts of men,
clergy as well as laity: though the Romanists teach otherwise. And the
bed undefiled - Consistent with the highest purity; though many
spiritual writers, so called, say it is only licensed whoredom. But
whoremongers and adulterers God will judge - Though they frequently
escape the sentence of men.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p5">5. He - God. Hath said - To all believers, in saying it to
Jacob, Joshua, and Solomon. <scripRef passage="Gen. xxviii. 15" id="i.xx.xiv-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|28|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.28.15">Gen.
xxviii, 15</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Josh. i. 5" id="i.xx.xiv-p5.2" parsed="|Josh|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.1.5">Josh. i,
5</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="1 Chr xxviii. 20" id="i.xx.xiv-p5.3" parsed="|1Chr|28|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.28.20">1 Chr xxviii,
20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p6">6. <scripRef passage="Psalm cxviii. 6" id="i.xx.xiv-p6.1" parsed="|Ps|118|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.118.6">Psalm cxviii,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p7">7. Remember them - Who are now with God, considering the
happy end of their conversation on earth.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p8">8. Men may die; but Jesus Christ, yea, and his gospel, is
the same from everlasting to everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p9">9. Be not carried about with various doctrines - Which
differ from that one faith in our one unchangeable Lord. Strange - To
the ears and hearts of all that abide in him. For it is good - It is
both honourable before God and pleasant and profitable That the heart be
stablished with grace - Springing from faith in Christ. Not with meats -
Jewish ceremonies, which indeed can never stablish the heart.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p10">10. On the former part of this verse, the fifteenth and
sixteenth depend; on the latter, the intermediate verses. We have an
altar - The cross of Christ. Whereof they have no right to eat - To
partake of the benefits which we receive therefrom. Who serve the
tabernacle - Who adhere to the Mosaic law.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p11">11. For - According to their own law, the sin-offerings
were wholly consumed, and no Jew ever ate thereof. But Christ was a
sin-offering. Therefore they cannot feed upon him, as we do, who are
freed from the Mosaic law.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p12">12. Wherefore Jesus also - Exactly answering those typical
sin- offerings. Suffered without the gate - Of Jerusalem, which answered
to the old camp of Israel. That he might sanctify - Reconcile and
consecrate to God. The people - Who believe in him. By his own blood -
Not those shadowy sacrifices, which are now of no further use.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p13">13. Let us then go forth without the camp - Out of the
Jewish dispensation. Bearing his reproach - All manner of shame,
obloquy, and contempt for his sake.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p14">14. For we have here - On earth No continuing city - All
things here are but for a moment; and Jerusalem itself was just then on
the point of being destroyed.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p15">15. The sacrifice - The altar is mentioned, ver. 10; now
the sacrifices:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.xiv-p16">1. Praise;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xx.xiv-p17">2. Beneficence; with both of which God is
well pleased.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p18">17. Obey them that have the rule over you - The word
implies also, that lead or guide you; namely, in truth and holiness. And
submit yourselves - Give up (not your conscience or judgment, but) your
own will, in all things purely indifferent. For they watch over your
souls - With all zeal and diligence, they guard and caution you against
all danger. As they that must give account - To the great Shepherd, for
every part of their behaviour toward you. How vigilant then ought every
pastor to be! How careful of every soul committed to his charge! That
they may do this - Watch over you. With joy and not with groans - He is
not a good shepherd, who does not either rejoice over them, or groan for
them. The groans of other creatures are heard: how much more shall these
come up in the ears of God! Whoever answers this character of a
Christian pastor may undoubtedly demand this obedience.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p19">20. The everlasting covenant - The Christian covenant,
which is not temporary, like the Jewish, but designed to remain for
ever. By the application of that blood, by which this covenant was
established, may he make you, in every respect, inwardly and outwardly
holy!</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p20">22. Suffer the word of exhortation - Addressed to you in
this letter, which, though longer than my usual letters, is yet
contained in few words, considering the copiousness of the subject.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p21">23. If he come - To me.</p>

<p id="i.xx.xiv-p22">25. - Grace be with you all - St. Paul's usual benediction.
God apply it to our hearts!</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE GENERAL EPISTLE OF ST. JAMES" progress="23.51%" prev="i.xx.xiv" next="i.xxi.i" id="i.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Jas" id="i.xxi-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xxi-p0.2">NOTES ON THE GENERAL EPISTLE OF ST. JAMES</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to James" progress="23.51%" prev="i.xxi" next="i.xxi.ii" id="i.xxi.i">

<p id="i.xxi.i-p1">THIS is supposed to have been written by James the son of
Alpheus the brother (or kinsman) of our Lord. It is called a General
Epistle, because written not to a particular person or church, but to
all the converted Israelites. Herein the apostle reproves that
antinomian spirit, which had even then infected many, who had perverted
the glorious doctrine of justification by faith into an occasion of
licentiousness. He likewise comforts the true believers under their
sufferings, and reminds them of the judgments that were approaching. It
has three parts:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxi.i-p2">I. The inscription, Chap. i. 1</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxi.i-p3">II. The exhortation,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxi.i-p4">1. To patience, enduring outward, conquering
inward, temptations, 2-15</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxi.i-p5">2. Considering the goodness of God, 16-18 to
be swift to hear, slow to speak, slow to wrath And these three are,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxi.i-p6">1. Proposed, 19-21</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxi.i-p7">2. Treated of at large.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxi.i-p8">a. Let hearing be joined with practice, 22-26
Particularly with bridling the tongue, 26 With mercy and purity, 27
Without respect of persons, ii. 1-13 And so faith universally with
works, 14-26</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxi.i-p9">b. Let the speech be modest, iii. 1-12</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxi.i-p10">c. Let anger, with all the other passions, be
restrained, 13- iv.1- 17</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxi.i-p11">3. To patience again.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxi.i-p12">a. Confirmed by the coming of the judge, in
which draws near The calamity of the wicked, v.1-6 The deliverance of
the righteous, 7-12</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxi.i-p13">b. Nourished by prayer, 13-18</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxi.i-p14">III. The conclusion, 19</p>
<h2 id="i.xxi.i-p14.1">JAMES</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="23.53%" prev="i.xxi.i" next="i.xxi.iii" id="i.xxi.ii">
<h3 id="i.xxi.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="James I" id="i.xxi.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Jas|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.1" /> 

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p1">1. A servant of Jesus Christ - Whose name the apostle
mentions but once more in the whole epistle, chap. ii, 1. And not at all
in his whole discourse, <scripRef passage="Acts xv. 14" id="i.xxi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Acts|15|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.15.14">Acts xv,
14</scripRef>, &amp;c.; or <scripRef passage="Acts xxi. 20-25" id="i.xxi.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Acts|21|20|21|25" osisRef="Bible:Acts.21.20-Acts.21.25">Acts xxi,
20-25</scripRef>. It might have seemed, if he mentioned him often, that he
did it out of vanity, as being the brother of the Lord. To the twelve
tribes - Of Israel; that is, those of them that believe. Which are
scattered abroad - In various countries. Ten of the tribes were
scattered ever since the reign of Hosea; and great part of the rest were
now dispersed through the Roman empire: as was foretold, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxviii. 25" id="i.xxi.ii-p1.3" parsed="|Deut|28|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.28.25">Deut. xxviii, 25</scripRef>, &amp;c.xxx, 4. Greeting - That is, all blessings, temporal
and eternal.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p2">2. My brethren, count it all joy - Which is the highest
degree of patience, and contains all the rest. When ye fall into divers
temptations - That is, trials.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p3">4. Let patience have its perfect work - Give it full scope,
under whatever trials befall you. That ye may be perfect and entire -
Adorned with every Christian grace. And wanting nothing - Which God
requires in you.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p4">5. If any want - The connection between the first and
following verses, both here and in the fourth chapter, will be easily
discerned by him who reads them, while he is suffering wrongfully. He
will then readily perceive, why the apostle mentions all those various
affections of the mind. Wisdom - To understand, whence and why
temptations come, and how they are to be improved. Patience is in every
pious man already. Let him exercise this, and ask for wisdom. The sum of
wisdom, both in the temptation of poverty and of riches, is described in
the ninth and tenth verses. Who giveth to all - That ask aright. And
upbraideth not - Either with their past wickedness, or present
unworthiness.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p5">6. But let him ask in faith - A firm confidence in God. St.
James also both begins and ends with faith, chap. v, 15; the hindrances
of which he removes in the middle part of his epistle. He that doubteth
is like a wave of the sea - Yea, such are all who have not asked and
obtained wisdom. Driven with the wind - From without. And tossed - From
within, by his own unstableness.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p6">8. A doubleminded man - Who has, as it were, two souls;
whose heart is not simply given up to God. Is unstable - Being without
the true wisdom; perpetually disagrees both with himself and others,
chap. iii, 16.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p7">9. Let the brother--St James does not give this
appellation to the rich. Of low degree - Poor and tempted. Rejoice - The
most effectual remedy against doublemindedness. In that he is exalted -
To be a child of God, and an heir of glory.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p8">10. But the rich, in that he is made low - Is humbled by a
deep sense of his true condition. Because as the flower - Beautiful, but
transient. He shall pass away - Into eternity.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p9">11. For the sun arose and withered the grass - There is an
unspeakable beauty and elegance, both in the comparison itself, and in
the very manner of expressing it, intimating both the certainty and the
suddenness of the event. So shall the rich fade away in his ways - In
the midst of his various pleasures and employments.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p10">12. Happy is the man that endureth temptation - Trials of
various kinds. He shall receive the crown - That fadeth not away. Which
the Lord hath promised to them that love him - And his enduring proves
his love. For it is love only that "endureth all things."</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p11">13. But let no man who is tempted - To sin. Say, I am
tempted of God - God thus tempteth no man.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p12">14. Every man is tempted, when - In the beginning of the
temptation. He is drawn away - Drawn out of God, his strong refuge. By
his own desire - We are therefore to look for the cause of every sin,
in, not out of ourselves. Even the injections of the devil cannot hurt
before we make them our own. And every one has desires arising from his
own constitution, tempers, habits, and way of life. And enticed - In the
progress of the temptation, catching at the bait: so the original word
signifies.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p13">15. Then desire having conceived - By our own will joining
therewith. Bringeth forth actual sin - It doth not follow that the
desire itself is not sin. He that begets a man is himself a man. And sin
being perfected - Grown up to maturity, which it quickly does. Bringeth
forth death - Sin is born big with death.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p14">16. Do not err - It is a grievous error to ascribe the evil
and not the good which we receive to God.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p15">17. No evil, but every good gift - Whatever tends to
holiness. And every perfect gift - Whatever tends to glory. Descendeth
from the Father of lights - The appellation of Father is here used with
peculiar propriety. It follows, "he begat us." He is the Father of all
light, material or spiritual, in the kingdom of grace and of glory. With
whom is no variableness - No change in his understanding. Or shadow of
turning - in his will. He infallibly discerns all good and evil; and
invariably loves one, and hates the other. There is, in both the Greek
words, a metaphor taken from the stars, particularly proper where the
Father of lights is mentioned. Both are applicable to any celestial
body, which has a daily vicissitude of day and night, and sometimes
longer days, sometimes longer nights. In God is nothing of this kind. He
is mere light. If there Is any such vicissitude, it is in ourselves, not
in him.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p16">18. Of his own will - Most loving, most free, most pure,
just opposite to our evil desire, ver. 15. Begat he us - Who believe. By
the word of truth - The true word, emphatically so termed; the gospel.
That we might be a kind of first-fruits of his creatures - Christians
are the chief and most excellent of his visible creatures; and sanctify
the rest. Yet he says, A kind of - For Christ alone is absolutely the
first-fruits.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p17">19. Let every man be swift to hear - This is treated of
from ver. 21 to the end of the next chapter. Slow to speak - Which is
treated of in the third chapter. Slow to wrath - Neither murmuring at
God, nor angry at his neighbour. This is treated of in the third, and
throughout the fourth and fifth chapters.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p18">20. The righteousness of God here includes all duties
prescribed by him, and pleasing to him.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p19">21. Therefore laying aside - As a dirty garment. All the
filthiness and superfluity of wickedness - For however specious or
necessary it may appear to worldly wisdom, all wickedness is both vile,
hateful, contemptible, and really superfluous. Every reasonable end may
be effectually answered without any kind or degree of it. Lay this,
every known sin, aside, or all your hearing is vain. With meekness -
Constant evenness and serenity of mind. Receive - Into your ears, your
heart, your life. The word - Of the gospel. Ingrafted - In believers, by
regeneration, ver. 18 and by habit, <scripRef passage="Heb. v. 14" id="i.xxi.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Heb|5|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.5.14">Heb.
v, 14</scripRef>. Which is able to save your souls - The hope of salvation
nourishes meekness.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p20">23. Beholding his face in a glass - How exactly does the
scripture glass show a man the face of his soul!</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p21">24. He beheld himself, and went away - To other business.
And forgot - But such forgetting does not excuse.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p22">25. But he that looketh diligently - Not with a transient
glance, but bending down, fixing his eyes, and searching all to the
bottom. Into the perfect law - Of love as established by faith. St.
James here guards us against misunderstanding what St. Paul says
concerning the "yoke and bondage of the law." He who keeps the law of
love is free, <scripRef passage="John viii. 31" id="i.xxi.ii-p22.1" parsed="|John|8|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.8.31">John viii,
31</scripRef>, &amp;c. He that does not, is not free, but a slave to sin,
and a criminal before God, ver. 10. And continueth therein - Not like
him who forgot it, and went away. This man - There is a peculiar force
in the repetition of the word. Shall be happy - Not barely in hearing,
but doing the will of God.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p23">26. If any one be ever so religious - Exact in the outward
offices of religion. And bridleth not his tongue - From backbiting,
talebearing, evilspeaking, he only deceiveth his own heart, if he
fancies he has any true religion at all.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.ii-p24">27. The only true religion in the sight of God, is this, to
visit - With counsel, comfort, and relief. The fatherless and widows -
Those who need it most. In their affliction - In their most helpless and
hopeless state. And to keep himself unspotted from the world - From the
maxims, tempers, and customs of it. But this cannot be done, till we
have given our hearts to God, and love our neighbour as ourselves.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="23.68%" prev="i.xxi.ii" next="i.xxi.iv" id="i.xxi.iii">
<h3 id="i.xxi.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="James II" id="i.xxi.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Jas|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.2" /> 

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p1">1. My brethren -- the equality of Christians, intimated by
this name, is the ground of the admonition. Hold not the faith of our
common Lord, the Lord of glory - Of which glory all who believe in him
partake. With respect of persons - That is, honour none merely for being
rich; despise none merely for being poor.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p2">2. With gold rings - Which were not then so common as
now.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p3">3. Ye look upon him - With respect.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p4">4. Ye distinguish not - To which the most respect is due,
to the poor or to the rich. But are become evil-reasoning Judges - You
reason ill, and so judge wrong: for fine apparel is no proof of worth in
him that wears it.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p5">5. Hearken - As if he had said, Stay, consider, ye that
judge thus. Does not the presumption lie rather in favour of the poor
man? Hath not God chosen the poor - That is, are not they whom God hath
chosen, generally speaking, poor in this world? who yet are rich in
faith, and heirs of the kingdom - Consequently, the most honourable of
men: and those whom God so highly honours, ought not ye to honour
likewise?</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p6">6. Do not the rich often oppress you - By open violence;
often drag you - Under colour of law.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p7">7. Do not they blaspheme that worthy name - Of God and of
Christ. The apostle speaks chiefly of rich heathens: but are Christians,
so called, a whit behind them?</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p8">8. If ye fulfil the royal law - The supreme law of the
great King which is love; and that to every man, poor as well as rich,
ye do well. <scripRef passage="Lev. xix. 18" id="i.xxi.iii-p8.1" parsed="|Lev|19|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.18">Lev. xix,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p9">9. Being convicted - By that very law. <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiii. 3" id="i.xxi.iii-p9.1" parsed="|Exod|23|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.23.3">Exod. xxiii, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p10">10. Whosoever keepeth the whole law, except in one point,
he is guilty of all - Is as liable to condemnation as if he had offended
in every point.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p11">11. For it is the same authority which establishes every
commandment.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p12">12. So speak and act - In all things. As they that shall be
judged - Without respect of persons. By the law of liberty - The gospel;
the law of universal love, which alone is perfect freedom. For their
transgressions of this, both in word and deed, the wicked shall be
condemned; and according to their works, done in obedience to this, the
righteous will be rewarded.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p13">13. Judgment without mercy shall be to him - In that day.
Who hath showed no mercy - To his poor brethren. But the mercy of God to
believers, answering to that which they have shown, will then glory over
judgment.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p14">14. From chap. i, 22, the apostle has been enforcing
Christian practice. He now applies to those who neglect this, under the
pretense of faith. St. Paul had taught that "a man is justified by faith
without the works of the law." This some began already to wrest to their
own destruction. Wherefore St. James, purposely repeating (ver. 21, 23,
25) the same phrases, testimonies, and examples, which St. Paul had
used, <scripRef passage="Rom. iv. 3" id="i.xxi.iii-p14.1" parsed="|Rom|4|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.4.3">Rom. iv, 3</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 17, 31" id="i.xxi.iii-p14.2" parsed="|Heb|11|17|0|0;|Heb|11|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.17 Bible:Heb.11.31">Heb. xi, 17, 31</scripRef>, refutes not the doctrine of St. Paul, but the error of
those who abused it. There is, therefore, no contradiction between the
apostles: they both delivered the truth of God, but in a different
manner, as having to do with different kinds of men. On another occasion
St. James himself pleaded the cause of faith, <scripRef passage="Acts xv. 13-21" id="i.xxi.iii-p14.3" parsed="|Acts|15|13|15|21" osisRef="Bible:Acts.15.13-Acts.15.21">Acts xv, 13-21</scripRef>; and St. Paul himself strenuously pleads for works,
particularly in his latter epistles. This verse is a summary of what
follows. What profiteth it? is enlarged on, ver. 15-17; though a man
say, ver. 18, 19 can that faith save him? ver. 20. It is not, though he
have faith; but, though he say he have faith. Here, therefore, true,
living faith is meant: but in other parts of the argument the apostle
speaks of a dead, imaginary faith. He does not, therefore, teach that
true faith can, but that it cannot, subsist without works: nor does he
oppose faith to works; but that empty name of faith, to real faith
working by love. Can that faith "which is without works" save him? No
more than it can profit his neighbour.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p15">17. So likewise that faith which hath not works is a mere
dead, empty notion; of no more profit to him that hath it, than the
bidding the naked be clothed is to him.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p16">18. But one - Who Judges better. Will say - To such a vain
talker. Show me, if thou canst, thy faith without thy works.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p17">19. Thou believest there is one God - I allow this: but
this proves only that thou hast the same faith with the devils. Nay,
they not only believe, but tremble - At the dreadful expectation of
eternal torments. So far is that faith from either justifying or saving
them that have it.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p18">20. But art than willing to know - Indeed thou art not:
thou wouldest fain be ignorant of it. O empty man - Empty of all
goodness. That the faith which is without works is dead - And so is not
properly faith, as a dead carcase is not a man.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p19">21. Was not Abraham justified by works - St. Paul says he
was justified by faith, <scripRef passage="Rom. iv. 2" id="i.xxi.iii-p19.1" parsed="|Rom|4|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.4.2">Rom. iv,
2</scripRef>, &amp;c.: yet St. James does not contradict him; for he does
not speak of the same justification. St. Paul speaks of that which
Abraham received many years before Isaac was born, <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 6" id="i.xxi.iii-p19.2" parsed="|Gen|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.6">Gen. xv, 6</scripRef>. St. James, of that which he did not receive till he had
offered up Isaac on the altar. He was justified, therefore, in St.
Paul's sense, (that is, accounted righteous,) by faith, antecedent to
his works. He was justified in St. James's sense, (that is, made
righteous,) by works, consequent to his faith. So that St. James's
justification by works is the fruit of St. Paul's justification by
faith.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p20">22. Thou seest that faith - For by faith Abraham offered
him, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 17" id="i.xxi.iii-p20.1" parsed="|Heb|11|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.17">Heb. xi, 17</scripRef>. Wrought together with his works - Therefore faith has one
energy and operation; works, another: and the energy and operation of
faith are before works, and together with them. Works do not give life
to faith, but faith begets works, and then is perfected by them. And by
works was faith made perfect - Here St. James fixes the sense wherein he
uses the word justified; so that no shadow of contradiction remains
between his assertion and St. Paul's. Abraham returned from that
sacrifice perfected in faith, and far higher in the favour of God. Faith
hath not its being from works, (for it is before them,) but its
perfection. That vigour of faith which begets works is then excited and
increased thereby, as the natural heat of the body begets motion,
whereby itself is then excited and increased. See <scripRef passage="1 John iii. 22" id="i.xxi.iii-p20.2" parsed="|1John|3|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.3.22">1 John iii, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p21">23. And the scripture - Which was afterwards written. Was
hereby eminently fulfilled, Abraham believed God, and it was imputed to
him for righteousness - This was twice fulfilled, - when Abraham first
believed, and when he offered up Isaac. St. Paul speaks of the former
fulfilling; St. James, of the latter. And he was called the Friend of
God - Both by his posterity, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xx. 7" id="i.xxi.iii-p21.1" parsed="|2Chr|20|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.20.7">2 Chron.
xx, 7</scripRef>; and by God himself, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xli. 8" id="i.xxi.iii-p21.2" parsed="|Isa|41|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.41.8">Isaiah xli, 8</scripRef> so pleasing to God were the works be wrought in faith. <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 6" id="i.xxi.iii-p21.3" parsed="|Gen|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.6">Gen. xv,
6</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p22">24. Ye see then that a man is justified by works, and not
by faith only - St. Paul, on the other hand, declares, "A man is
justified by faith," and not by works, <scripRef passage="Rom. iii. 28" id="i.xxi.iii-p22.1" parsed="|Rom|3|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.3.28">Rom. iii, 28</scripRef>. And yet there is no contradiction between the apostles:
because,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxi.iii-p23">1. They do not speak of the same faith: St.
Paul speaking of living faith; St. James here, of dead faith.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxi.iii-p24">2. They do not speak of the same works: St.
Paul speaking of works antecedent to faith; St. James, of works
subsequent to it.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iii-p25">25. After Abraham, the father of the Jews, the apostle
cites Rahab, a woman, and a sinner of the gentiles; to show, that in
every nation and sex true faith produces works, and is perfected by
them; that is, by the grace of God working in the believer, while he is
showing his faith by his works.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="23.81%" prev="i.xxi.iii" next="i.xxi.v" id="i.xxi.iv">
<h3 id="i.xxi.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="James III" id="i.xxi.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Jas|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.3" /> 

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p1">1. Be not many teachers - Let no more of you take this upon
you than God thrusts out; seeing it is so hard not to offend in speaking
much. Knowing that we - That all who thrust themselves into the office.
Shall receive greater condemnation - For more offenses. St. James here,
as in several of the following verses, by a common figure of speech,
includes himself: we shall receive, - we offend, - we put bits, - we
curse - None of which, as common sense shows, are to be interpreted
either of him or of the other apostles.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p2">2. The same is able to bridle the whole body - That is, the
whole man. And doubtless some are able to do this, and so are in this
sense perfect.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p3">3. We - That is, men.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p4">5. Boasteth great things - Hath great influence.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p5">6. A world of iniquity - Containing an immense quantity of
all manner of wickedness. It defileth - As fire by its smoke. The whole
body - The whole man. And setteth on fire the course of nature - All the
passions, every wheel of his soul.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p6">7. Every kind - The expression perhaps is not to be taken
strictly. Reptiles - That is, creeping things.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p7">8. But no man can tame the tongue - Of another; no, nor his
own, without peculiar help from God.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p8">9. Men made after the likeness of God - Indeed we have now
lost this likeness; yet there remains from thence an indelible
nobleness, which we ought to reverence both in ourselves and others.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p9">13. Let him show his wisdom as well as his faith by his
works; not by words only.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p10">14. If ye have bitter zeal - True Christian zeal is only
the flame of love. Even in your hearts - Though it went no further. Do
not lie against the truth - As if such zeal could consist with heavenly
wisdom.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p11">15. This wisdom - Which is consistent with such zeal. Is
earthly - Not heavenly; not from the Father of Lights. Animal - Not
spiritual; not from the Spirit of God. Devilish - Not the gift of
Christ, but such as Satan breathes into the soul.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p12">17. But the wisdom from above is first pure - From all that
is earthly, natural, devilish. Then peaceable - True peace attending
purity, it is quiet, inoffensive. Gentle - Soft, mild, yielding, not
rigid. Easy to be entreated - To be persuaded, or convinced; not
stubborn, sour, or morose. Full of good fruits - Both in the heart and
in the life, two of which are immediately specified. Without partiality
- Loving all, without respect of persons; embracing all good things,
rejecting all evil. And without dissimulation - Frank, open.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.iv-p13">18. And the principle productive of this righteousness is
sown, like good seed, in the peace of a believer's mind, and brings
forth a plentiful harvest of happiness, (which is the proper fruit of
righteousness,) for them that make peace - That labour to promote this
pure and holy peace among all men.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="23.86%" prev="i.xxi.iv" next="i.xxi.vi" id="i.xxi.v">
<h3 id="i.xxi.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="James IV" id="i.xxi.v-p0.2" parsed="|Jas|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.4" /> 

<p id="i.xxi.v-p1">1. From whence come wars and fightings - Quarrels and wars
among you, quite opposite to this peace? Is it not from your pleasures -
Your desires of earthly pleasures. Which war - Against your souls. In
your members - Here is the first seat of the war. Hence proceeds the war
of man with man, king with king, nation with nation.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p2">2. Ye kill - In your heart, for "he that hateth his brother
is a murderer." Ye fight and war - That is, furiously strive and
contend. Ye ask not - And no marvel; for a man full of evil desire, of
envy or hatred, cannot pray.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p3">3. But if ye do ask, ye receive not, because ye ask amiss -
That is, from a wrong motive.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p4">4. Ye adulterers and adulteresses - Who have broken your
faith with God, your rightful spouse. Know ye not that the friendship or
love of the world - The desire of the flesh, the desire of the eye, and
the pride of life, or courting the favour of worldly men, is enmity
against God? Whosoever desireth to be a friend of the world - Whosoever
seeks either the happiness or favour of it, does thereby constitute
himself an enemy of God; and can he expect to obtain anything of
him?</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p5">5. Do you think that the scripture saith in vain - Without
good ground. St. James seems to refer to many, not any one particular
scripture. The spirit of love that dwelleth in all believers lusteth
against envy - <scripRef passage="Gal. v. 17" id="i.xxi.v-p5.1" parsed="|Gal|5|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.5.17">Gal. v, 17</scripRef>; is directly opposite to all those unloving tempers which
necessarily flow from the friendship of the world.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p6">6. But he giveth greater grace - To all who shun those
tempers. Therefore it - The scripture. Saith, God resisteth the proud -
And pride is the great root of all unkind affections. <scripRef passage="Prov. iii. 34" id="i.xxi.v-p6.1" parsed="|Prov|3|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.3.34">Prov. iii, 34</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p7">7. Therefore by humbly submitting yourselves to God, resist
the devil - The father of pride and envy.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p8">8. Then draw nigh to God in prayer, and he will draw nigh
unto you, will hear you; which that nothing may hinder, cleanse your
hands - Cease from doing evil. And purify your hearts - From all
spiritual adultery. Be no more double minded, vainly endeavouring to
serve both God and mammon.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p9">9. Be afflicted - For your past unfaithfulness to God.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p10">11. Speak not evil one of another - This is a grand
hindrance of peace. O who is sufficiently aware of it! He that speaketh
evil of another does in effect speak evil of the law, which so strongly
prohibits it. Thou art not a doer of the law, but a judge - Of it; thou
settest thyself above, and as it were condemnest, it.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p11">12. There is one lawgiver that is able - To execute the
sentence he denounces. But who art thou - A poor, weak, dying worm.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p12">13. Come now, ye that say - As peremptorily as if your life
were in your own hands.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p13">15. Instead of your saying - That is, whereas ye ought to
say.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.v-p14">17. Therefore to him that knoweth to do good and doeth it
not - That knows what is right, and does not practice it. To him it is
sin - This knowledge does not prevent, but increase, his
condemnation.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="23.91%" prev="i.xxi.v" next="i.xxii" id="i.xxi.vi">
<h3 id="i.xxi.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="James V" id="i.xxi.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Jas|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.5" /> 

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p1">1. Come now, ye rich - The apostle does not speak this so
much for the sake of the rich themselves, as of the poor children of
God, who were then groaning under their cruel oppression. Weep and howl
for your miseries which are coming upon you - Quickly and unexpectedly.
This was written not long before the siege of Jerusalem; during which,
as well as after it, huge calamities came on the Jewish nation, not only
in Judea, but through distant countries. And as these were an awful
prelude of that wrath which was to fall upon them in the world to come,
so this may likewise refer to the final vengeance which will then be
executed on the impenitent.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p2">2. The riches of the ancients consisted much in large
stores of corn, and of costly apparel.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p3">3. The canker of them - Your perishing stores and moth-eaten
garments. Will be a testimony against you - Of your having buried those
talents in the earth, instead of improving them according to your Lord's
will. And will eat your flesh as fire - Will occasion you as great
torment as if fire were consuming your flesh. Ye have laid up treasure
in the last days - When it is too late; when you have no time to enjoy
them.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p4">4. The hire of your labourers crieth - Those sins chiefly
cry to God concerning which human laws are silent. Such are luxury,
unchastity, and various kinds of injustice. The labourers themselves
also cry to God, who is just coming to avenge their cause. Of sabaoth -
Of hosts, or armies.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p5">5. Ye have cherished your hearts - Have indulged yourselves
to the uttermost. As in a day of sacrifice - Which were solemn feast-
days among the Jews.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p6">6. Ye have killed the just - Many just men; in particular,
"that Just One," <scripRef passage="Acts iii. 14" id="i.xxi.vi-p6.1" parsed="|Acts|3|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.3.14">Acts iii,
14</scripRef>. They afterwards killed James, surnamed the Just, the writer
of this epistle. He doth not resist you - And therefore you are secure.
But the Lord cometh quickly, ver. 8.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p7">7. The husbandman waiteth for the precious fruit - Which
will recompense his labour and patience. Till he receives the former
rain - Immediately after sowing. And the latter - Before the
harvest.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p8">8. Stablish your hearts - In faith and patience. For the
coming of the Lord - To destroy Jerusalem. Is nigh - And so is his last
coming to the eye of a believer.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p9">9. Murmur not one against another - Have patience also with
each other. The judge standeth before the door - Hearing every word,
marking every thought.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p10">10. Take the prophets for an example - Once persecuted like
you, even for speaking in the name of the Lord. The very men that
gloried in having prophets yet could not bear their message: nor did
either their holiness or their high commission screen them from
suffering.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p11">11. We count them happy that endured - That suffered
patiently. The more they once suffered, the greater is their present
happiness. Ye have seen the end of the Lord - The end which the Lord
gave him.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p12">12. Swear not - However provoked. The Jews were notoriously
guilty of common swearing, though not so much by God himself as by some
of his creatures. The apostle here particularly forbids these oaths, as
well as all swearing in common conversation. It is very observable, how
solemnly the apostle introduces this command: above all things, swear
not - As if he had said, Whatever you forget, do not forget this. This
abundantly demonstrates the horrible iniquity of the crime. But he does
not forbid the taking a solemn oath before a magistrate. Let your yea be
yea; and your nay, nay - Use no higher asseverations in common
discourse; and let your word stand firm. Whatever ye say, take care to
make it good.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p13">14. Having anointed him with oil - This single conspicuous
gift, which Christ committed to his apostles, <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 13" id="i.xxi.vi-p13.1" parsed="|Mark|6|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.13">Mark vi, 13</scripRef>, remained in the church long after the other miraculous
gifts were withdrawn. Indeed, it seems to have been designed to remain
always; and St. James directs the elders, who were the most, if not the
only, gifted men, to administer at. This was the whole process of physic
in the Christian church, till it was lost through unbelief. That novel
invention among the Romanists, extreme unction, practiced not for cure,
but where life is despaired of, bears no manner of resemblance to
this.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p14">15. And the prayer offered in faith shall save the sick -
From his sickness; and if any sin be the occasion of his sickness, it
shall be forgiven him.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p15">16. Confess your faults - Whether ye are sick or in health.
To one another - He does not say, to the elders: this may, or may not,
be done; for it is nowhere commanded. We may confess them to any who can
pray in faith: he will then know how to pray for us, and be more stirred
up so to do. And pray one for another, that ye may be healed - Of all
your spiritual diseases.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p16">17. Elijah was a man of like passions - Naturally as weak
and sinful as we are. And he prayed - When idolatry covered the
land.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p17">18. He prayed again - When idolatry was abolished.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p18">19. As if he had said, I have now warned you of those sins
to which you are most liable; and, in all these respects, watch not only
over yourselves, but every one over his brother also. labour, in
particular, to recover those that are fallen. If any one err from the
truth - Practically, by sin.</p>

<p id="i.xxi.vi-p19">20. He shall save a soul - Of how much more value than the
body! ver. 14. And hide a multitude of sins - Which shall no more, how
many soever they are, be remembered to his condemnation.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE FIRST EPISTLE GENERAL OF ST. PETER" progress="24.01%" prev="i.xxi.vi" next="i.xxii.i" id="i.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1Pet" id="i.xxii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xxii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE FIRST EPISTLE GENERAL OF ST. PETER</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to First Peter" progress="24.01%" prev="i.xxii" next="i.xxii.ii" id="i.xxii.i">

<p id="i.xxii.i-p1">THERE is a wonderful weightiness, and yet liveliness and
sweetness, in the epistles of St. Peter. His design in both is, to stir
up the minds of those to whom he writes, by way of remembrance, <scripRef passage="2 Pet. iii. 1" id="i.xxii.i-p1.1" parsed="|2Pet|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.3.1">2 Pet. iii, 1</scripRef>, and to guard them, not only against error, but also against
doubting, chap. v, 12. This he does by reminding them of that glorious
grace which God had vouchsafed them through the gospel, by which
believers are inflamed to bring forth the fruits of faith, hope, love,
and patience. The parts of this epistle are three: -</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxii.i-p2">I. The inscription, Chap. i. 1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxii.i-p3">II. The stirring up of them to whom he
writes:</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxii.i-p4">1. As born of God. Here he recites and
interweaves alternately both the benefits of God toward believers, and
the duties of believers toward God:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.i-p5">1. God hath regenerated us to a living hope,
to an eternal inheritance, 3-12 Therefore hope to the end, 13</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.i-p6">2. As obedient children bring forth the fruit
of faith to your heavenly Father, 14-21</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.i-p7">3. Being purified by the Spirit, love with a
pure heart, 22, C.ii.10</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxii.i-p8">2. As strangers in the world, abstain from
fleshly desires, 11 And show your faith by,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.i-p9">1. A good conversation, 12</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.i-p10">a. In particular, Subjects, 13-17 Servants,
after the example of Christ, 18-25 Wives, iii. 1-6 Husbands, 7</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.i-p11">b. In general, all, 8-15</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.i-p12">2. A good profession,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.i-p13">a. By readiness to give an answer to every
one, 15-22</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.i-p14">b. By shunning evil company, iv.1-6 (This
part is enforced by what Christ both did and suffered, from his passion
to his coming to judgment.)</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.i-p15">c. By the exercise of Christian virtues, and
by a due use of miraculous gifts, 7-11</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxii.i-p16">3. As fellow-heirs of glory, sustain
adversity, let each do this,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.i-p17">1. In general, as a Christian, 12-19</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.i-p18">2. In his own particular state, v. 1-11 The
title beloved divides the second part from the first, ii 11 and the
third from the second, iv. 12</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxii.i-p19">III. The conclusion, 12-14</p>
<h2 id="i.xxii.i-p19.1">1st PETER</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="24.04%" prev="i.xxii.i" next="i.xxii.iii" id="i.xxii.ii">
<h3 id="i.xxii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Pet. I" id="i.xxii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|1Pet|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.1" /> 

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p1">1. To the sojourners - Upon earth, the Christians, chiefly
those of Jewish extraction. Scattered - Long ago driven out of their own
land. Those scattered by the persecution mentioned <scripRef passage="Acts viii. 1" id="i.xxii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Acts|8|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.8.1">Acts viii, 1</scripRef>, were scattered only through Judea and Samaria, though
afterwards some of them travelled to Phenice, Cyprus, and Antioch.
Through Pontus, Galatia, Cappadocia, Asia, and Bithynia - He names these
five provinces in the order wherein they occurred to him, writing from
the east. All these countries lie in the Lesser Asia. The Asia here
distinguished from the other provinces is that which was usually called
the Proconsular Asia being a Roman province.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p2">2. According to the foreknowledge of God - Speaking after
the manner of men. Strictly speaking, there is no foreknowledge, no more
than afterknowledge, with God: but all things are known to him as
present from eternity to eternity. This is therefore no other than an
instance of the divine condescension to our low capacities. Elect - By
the free love and almighty power of God taken out of, separated from,
the world. Election, in the scripture sense, is God's doing anything
that our merit or power have no part in. The true predestination, or
fore-appointment of God is,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.ii-p3">1. He that believeth shall be saved from the
guilt and power of sin.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.ii-p4">2. He that endureth to the end shall be saved
eternally.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.ii-p5">3. They who receive the precious gift of
faith, thereby become the sons of God; and, being sons, they shall
receive the Spirit of holiness to walk as Christ also walked. Throughout
every part of this appointment of God, promise and duty go hand in hand.
All is free gift; and yet such is the gift, that the final issue depends
on our future obedience to the heavenly call. But other predestination
than this, either to life or death eternal, the scripture knows not of.
Moreover, it is.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.ii-p6">1. Cruel respect of persons; an unjust regard
of one, and an unjust disregard of another. It is mere creature
partiality, and not infinite justice.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.ii-p7">2. It is not plain scripture doctrine, if
true; but rather, inconsistent with the express written word, that
speaks of God's universal offers of grace; his invitations, promises,
threatenings, being all general.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.ii-p8">3. We are bid to choose life, and reprehended
for not doing it.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.ii-p9">4. It is inconsistent with a state of
probation in those that must be saved or must be lost.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxii.ii-p10">5. It is of fatal consequence; all men being
ready, on very slight grounds, to fancy themselves of the elect number.
But the doctrine of predestination is entirely changed from what it
formerly was. Now it implies neither faith, peace, nor purity. It is
something that will do without them all. Faith is no longer, according
to the modern predestinarian scheme, a divine "evidence of things not
seen," wrought in the soul by the immediate power of the Holy Ghost; not
an evidence at all; but a mere notion. Neither is faith made any longer
a means of holiness; but something that will do without it. Christ is no
more a saviour from sin; but a defense, a countenancer of it. He is no
more a fountain of spiritual life in the soul of believers, but leaves
his elect inwardly dry, and outwardly unfruitful; and is made little
more than a refuge from the image of the heavenly; even from
righteousness, peace, and joy in the Holy Ghost. Through sanctification
of the Spirit - Through the renewing and purifying influences of his
Spirit on their souls. Unto obedience - To engage and enable them to
yield themselves up to all holy obedience, the foundation of all which
is, the sprinkling of the blood of Jesus Christ - The atoning blood of
Christ, which was typified by the sprinkling of the blood of sacrifices
under the law; in allusion to which it is called "the blood of
sprinkling."</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p11">3. Blessed be the God and Father of our Lord Jesus Christ -
His Father, with respect to his divine nature; his God, with respect to
his human. Who hath regenerated us to a living hope - An hope which
implies true spiritual life, which revives the heart, and makes the soul
lively and vigourous. By the resurrection of Christ - Which is not only
a pledge of ours, but a part of the purchase price. It has also a close
connection with our rising from spiritual death, that as he liveth, so
shall we live with him. He was acknowledged to be the Christ, but
usually called Jesus till his resurrection; then he was also called
Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p12">4. To an inheritance - For if we are sons, then heirs.
Incorruptible - Not like earthly treasures. Undefiled - Pure and holy,
incapable of being itself defiled, or of being enjoyed by any polluted
soul. And that fadeth not away - That never decays in its value,
sweetness, or beauty, like all the enjoyments of this world, like the
garlands of leaves or flowers, with which the ancient conquerors were
wont to be crowned. Reserved in heaven for you - Who "by patient
continuance in welldoing, seek for glory and honour and
immortality."</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p13">5. Who are kept - The inheritance is reserved; the heirs
are kept for it. By the power of God - Which worketh all in all, which
guards us against all our enemies. Through faith - Through which alone
salvation is both received and retained. Ready to be revealed - That
Rev. is made in the last day. It was more and more ready to be revealed,
ever since Christ came.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p14">6. Wherein - That is, in being so kept. Ye even now greatly
rejoice, though now for a little while - Such is our whole life,
compared to eternity. If need be - For it is not always needful. If God
sees it to be the best means for your spiritual profit. Ye are in
heaviness - Or sorrow; but not in darkness; for they still retained both
faith, <scripRef passage="1 Pe. i. 5" id="i.xxii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|1Pet|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.1.5">1 Pe i, 5</scripRef>, hope, and love; yea, at this very time were rejoicing with
joy unspeakable, <scripRef passage="1 Pe. 1 i. 8" id="i.xxii.ii-p14.2" parsed="|1Pet|1|0|0|0;|1Pet|1|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.1 Bible:1Pet.1.8">1 Pe i, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p15">7. That the trial of your faith - That is, your faith which
is tried. Which is much more precious than gold - For gold, though it
bear the fire, yet will perish with the world. May be found - Though it
doth not yet appear. Unto praise - From God himself. And honour - From
men and angels. And glory - Assigned by the great Judge.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p16">8. Having not seen - In the flesh.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p17">9. Receiving - Now already. Salvation - From all sin into
all holiness, which is the qualification for, the forerunner and pledge
of, eternal salvation.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p18">10. Of which salvation - So far beyond all that was
experienced under the Jewish dispensation. The very prophets who
prophesied long ago of the grace of God toward you - Of his abundant,
overflowing grace to be bestowed on believers under the Christian
dispensation. Inquired - Were earnestly inquisitive. And searched
diligently - Like miners searching after precious ore, after the meaning
of the prophecies which they delivered.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p19">11. Searching what time - What particular period. And what
manner of time - By what marks to be distinguished. The glories that
were to follow - His sufferings; namely, the glory of his resurrection,
ascension, exaltation, and the effusion of his Spirit; the glory of the
last judgment, and of his eternal kingdom; and also the glories of his
grace in the hearts and lives of Christians.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p20">12. To whom - So searching. It was revealed, that not for
themselves, but for us they ministered - They did not so much by those
predictions serve themselves, or that generation, as they did us, who
now enjoy what they saw afar off. With the Holy Ghost sent down from
heaven - Confirmed by the inward, powerful testimony of the Holy Ghost,
as well as the mighty effusion of his miraculous gifts. Which things
angels desire to look into - A beautiful gradation; prophets, righteous
men, kings, desired to see and hear what Christ did and taught. What the
Holy Ghost taught concerning Christ the very angels long to know.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p21">13. Wherefore - Having such encouragement. Gird up the
loins of your mind - As persons in the eastern countries were wont, in
travelling or running, to gird up their long garments, so gather ye up
all your thoughts and affections, and keep your mind always
disencumbered and prepared to run the race which is set before you. Be
watchful - As servants that wait for their Lord. And hope to the end -
Maintain a full expectation of all the grace - The blessings flowing
from the free favour of God. Which shall be brought to you at the final
Revelation of Jesus Christ - And which are now brought to you by the
Revelation of Christ in you.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p22">14. Your desires - Which ye had while ye were ignorant of
God.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p23">16. <scripRef passage="Lev. xi. 44" id="i.xxii.ii-p23.1" parsed="|Lev|11|44|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.11.44">Lev. xi,
44</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p24">17. Who judgeth according to every man's work - According
to the tenor of his life and conversation. Pass the time of your
sojourning - Your short abode on earth. In humble, loving fear - The
proper companion and guard of hope.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p25">18. Your vain conversation - Your foolish, sinful way of
life.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p26">19. Without blemish - In himself. Without spot - From the
world.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p27">21. Who through him believe - For all our faith and hope
proceed from the power of his resurrection. In God that raised Jesus,
and gave him glory - At his ascension. Without Christ we should only
dread God; whereas through him we believe, hope, and love.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p28">22. Having purified your souls by obeying the truth through
the Spirit, who bestows upon you freely, both obedience and purity of
heart, and unfeigned love of the brethren, go on to still higher degrees
of love. Love one another fervently - With the most strong and tender
affection; and yet with a pure heart - Pure from any spot of unholy
desire or inordinate passion.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p29">23. Which liveth - Is full of divine virtue. And abideth
the same forever.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.ii-p30">24. All flesh - Every human creature is transient and
withering as grass. And all the glory of it - His wisdom, strength,
wealth, righteousness. As the flower - The most short-lived part of it.
The grass - That is, man. The flower - That is, his glory. Is fallen off
- As it were, while we are speaking. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 6" id="i.xxii.ii-p30.1" parsed="|Isa|40|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.6">Isaiah xl, 6</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="24.21%" prev="i.xxii.ii" next="i.xxii.iv" id="i.xxii.iii">
<h3 id="i.xxii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Pet. II" id="i.xxii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|1Pet|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.2" /> 

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p1">1. Wherefore laying aside - As inconsistent with that pure
love. All dissimulation - Which is the outward expression of guile in
the heart.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p2">2. Desire - Always, as earnestly as new born babes do,
chap. i, 3. The milk of the word - That word of God which nourishes the
soul as milk does the body, and which is sincere, pure from all guile,
so that none are deceived who cleave to it. That you may grow thereby -
In faith, love, holiness, unto the full stature of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p3">3. Since ye have tasted - Sweetly and experimentally
known.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p4">4. To whom coming - By faith. As unto a living stone -
Living from eternity; alive from the dead. There is a wonderful beauty
and energy in these expressions, which describe Christ as a spiritual
foundation, solid, firm, durable; and believers as a building erected
upon it, in preference to that temple which the Jews accounted their
highest glory. And St. Peter speaking of him thus, shows he did not
judge himself, but Christ, to be the rock on which the church was built.
Rejected indeed by men - Even at this day, not only by Jews, Turks,
heathens, infidels; but by all Christians, so called, who live in sin,
or who hope to be saved by their own works. But chosen of God - From all
eternity, to be the foundation of his church. And precious - In himself,
in the sight of God, and in the eyes of all believers.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p5">5. Ye - Believers. As living stones - Alive to God through
him. Are built up - In union with each other. A spiritual house - Being
spiritual yourselves, and an habitation of God through the Spirit. An
holy priesthood - Consecrated to God, and "holy as he is holy." To offer
up - Your souls and bodies, with all your thoughts, words, and actions,
as spiritual sacrifices to God.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p6">6. He that believeth shall not be confounded - In time or
in eternity. <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxviii. 16" id="i.xxii.iii-p6.1" parsed="|Isa|28|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.28.16">Isaiah xxviii,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p7">7. To them who believe, he is become the head of the corner
- The chief corner stone, on which the whole building rests. Unbelievers
too will at length find him such to their sorrow, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxi. 44" id="i.xxii.iii-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|21|44|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.21.44">Matt. xxi, 44</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="Psalm cxviii. 22" id="i.xxii.iii-p7.2" parsed="|Ps|118|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.118.22">Psalm cxviii, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p8">8. Who stumble, whereunto also they were appointed - They
who believe not, stumble, and fall, and perish forever; God having
appointed from all eternity, "he that believeth not shall be
damned."</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p9">9. But ye - Who believe in Christ Are - In a higher sense
than ever the Jews were. A chosen or elect race, a royal priesthood -
"Kings and priests unto God," <scripRef passage="Rev. i. 6" id="i.xxii.iii-p9.1" parsed="|Rev|1|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.1.6">Rev. i,
6</scripRef>. As princes, ye have power with God, and victory over sin,
the world, and the devil: as priests, ye are consecrated to God, for
offering spiritual sacrifices. Ye Christians are as one holy nation,
under Christ your King. A purchased people - Who are his peculiar
property. That ye may show forth - By your whole behaviour, to all
mankind. The virtues - The excellent glory, the mercy, wisdom, and power
of him, Christ, who hath called you out of the darkness of ignorance,
error, sin, and misery.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p10">10. Who in time past were not a people - Much less the
people of God; but scattered individuals of many nations. The former
part of the verse particularly respects the gentiles; the latter, the
Jews.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p11">11. Here begins the exhortation drawn from the second
motive. Sojourners: pilgrims - The first word properly means, those who
are in a strange house; the second, those who are in a strange country.
You sojourn in the body; you are pilgrims in this world. Abstain from
desires of anything in this house, or in this country.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p12">12. Honest - Not barely unblamable, but virtuous in every
respect. But our language sinks under the force, beauty, and copiousness
of the original expressions. That they by your good works which they
shall behold - See with their own eyes. May glorify God - By owning his
grace in you, and following your example. In the day of visitation - The
time when he shall give them fresh offers of his mercy.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p13">13. Submit yourselves to every ordinance of man - To every
secular power. Instrumentally these are ordained by men; but originally
all their power is from God.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p14">14. Or to subordinate governors, or magistrates.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p15">15. The ignorance - Of them who blame you, because they do
not know you: a strong motive to pity them.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p16">16. As free - Yet obeying governors, for God's sake.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p17">17. honour all men - As being made in the image of God,
bought by his Son, and designed for his kingdom. honour the king - Pay
him all that regard both in affection and action which the laws of God
and man require.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p18">18. Servants - Literally, household servants. With all fear
- Of offending them or God. Not only to the good - Tender, kind. And
gentle - Mild, easily forgiving.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p19">19. For conscience toward God - From a pure desire of
pleasing him. Grief - Severe treatment.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p20">21. Hereunto are ye - Christians. Called - To suffer
wrongfully. Leaving you an example - When he went to God. That ye might
follow his steps - Of innocence and patience.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p21">22, 23. In all these instances the example of Christ is
peculiarly adapted to the state of servants, who easily slide either
into sin or guile, reviling their fellowservants, or threatening them,
the natural result of anger without power. He committed himself to him
that judgeth righteously - The only solid ground of patience in
affliction. <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 4, 6, 7, 9" id="i.xxii.iii-p21.1" parsed="|Isa|53|4|0|0;|Isa|53|6|0|0;|Isa|53|7|0|0;|Isa|53|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.4 Bible:Isa.53.6 Bible:Isa.53.7 Bible:Isa.53.9">Isaiah liii, 4,
6, 7, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p22">22, 23. In all these instances the example of Christ is
peculiarly adapted to the state of servants, who easily slide either
into sin or guile, reviling their fellowservants, or threatening them,
the natural result of anger without power. He committed himself to him
that judgeth righteously - The only solid ground of patience in
affliction.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p23">24. Who himself bore our sins - That is, the punishment due
to them. In his afflicted, torn, dying body on the tree - The cross,
whereon chiefly slaves or servants were wont to suffer. That we being
dead to sin - Wholly delivered both from the guilt and power of it:
indeed, without an atonement first made for the guilt, we could never
have been delivered from the power. Might live to righteousness - Which
is one only. The sins we had committed, and he bore, were manifold.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iii-p24">25. The bishop - The kind observer, inspector, or overseer
of your souls.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="24.32%" prev="i.xxii.iii" next="i.xxii.v" id="i.xxii.iv">
<h3 id="i.xxii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Pet. III" id="i.xxii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|1Pet|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.3" /> 

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p1">1. If any - He speaks tenderly. Won - Gained over to
Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p2">2. Joined with a loving fear of displeasing them.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p3">3. Three things are here expressly forbidden: curling the
hair, wearing gold, (by way of ornament,) and putting on costly or gay
apparel. These, therefore, ought never to be allowed, much less
defended, by Christians.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p4">4. The hidden man of the heart - Complete inward holiness,
which implies a meek and quiet spirit. A meek spirit gives no trouble
willingly to any: a quiet spirit bears all wrongs without being
troubled. In the sight of God - Who looks at the heart. All superfluity
of dress contributes more to pride and anger than is generally supposed.
The apostle seems to have his eye to this by substituting meekness and
quietness in the room of the ornaments he forbids. "I do not regard
these things," is often said by those whose hearts are wrapped up in
them: but offer to take them away, and you touch the very idol of their
soul. Some, indeed only dress elegantly that they may be looked on; that
is, they squander away their Lord's talent to gain applause: thus making
sin to beget sin, and then plead one in excuse of the other.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p5">5. The adorning of those holy women, who trusted in God,
and therefore did not act thus from servile fear, was,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.iv-p6">1. Their meek subjection to their
husbands:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.iv-p7">2. Their quiet spirit, "not afraid," or
amazed: and</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxii.iv-p8">3. Their unblamable behaviour, "doing" all
things "well."</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p9">6. Whose children ye are - In a spiritual as well as
natural sense, and entitled to the same inheritance, while ye discharge
your conjugal duties, not out of fear, but for conscience' sake. <scripRef passage="Gen. xviii. 12" id="i.xxii.iv-p9.1" parsed="|Gen|18|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.18.12">Gen. xviii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p10">7. Dwell with the woman according to knowledge - Knowing
they are weak, and therefore to be used with all tenderness. Yet do not
despise them for this, but give them honour - Both in heart, in word,
and in action; as those who are called to be joint-heirs of that eternal
life which ye and they hope to receive by the free grace of God. That
your prayers be not hindered - On the one part or the other. All sin
hinders prayer; particularly anger. Anything at which we are angry is
never more apt to come into our mind than when we are at prayer; and
those who do not forgive will find no forgiveness from God.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p11">8. Finally - This part of the epistle reaches to chap. iv,
11. The apostle seems to have added the rest afterwards. Sympathizing -
Rejoicing and sorrowing together. Love all believers as brethren. Be
pitiful - Toward the afflicted. Be courteous - To all men. Courtesy is
such a behaviour toward equals and inferiors as shows respect mixed with
love.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p12">9. Ye are called to inherit a blessing - Therefore their
railing cannot hurt you; and, by blessing them, you imitate God, who
blesses you.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p13">10. For he that desireth to love life, and to see good days
- That would make life amiable and desirable. <scripRef passage="Psalm xxxiv. 12" id="i.xxii.iv-p13.1" parsed="|Ps|34|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.34.12">Psalm xxxiv, 12</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p14">11. Let him seek - To live peaceably with all men. And
pursue it - Even when it seems to flee from him.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p15">12. The eyes of the Lord are over the righteous - For good.
Anger appears in the whole face; love, chiefly in the eyes.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p16">13. Who is he that will harm you - None can.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p17">14. But if ye should suffer - This is no harm to you, but a
good. Fear ye not their fear - The very words of the Septuagint, <scripRef passage="Isaiah viii. 12, 13" id="i.xxii.iv-p17.1" parsed="|Isa|8|12|8|13" osisRef="Bible:Isa.8.12-Isa.8.13">Isaiah viii, 12, 13</scripRef>. Let not that fear be in you which the wicked feel.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p18">15. But sanctify the Lord God in your hearts - Have an holy
fear, and a full trust in his wise providence. The hope - Of eternal
life. With meekness - For anger would hurt your cause as well as your
soul. And fear - A filial fear of offending God, and a jealousy over
yourselves, lest ye speak amiss.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p19">16. Having a good conscience - So much the more beware of
anger, to which the very consciousness of your innocence may betray you.
Join with a good conscience meekness and fear, and you obtain a complete
victory. Your good conversation in Christ - That is, which flows from
faith in him.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p20">17. It is infinitely better, if it be the will of God, ye
should suffer. His permissive will appears from his providence.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p21">18. For - This is undoubtedly best, whereby we are most
conformed to Christ. Now Christ suffered once - To suffer no more. For
sins - Not his own, but ours. The just for the unjust - The word
signifies, not only them who have wronged their neighbours, but those
who have transgressed any of the commands of God; as the preceding word,
just, denotes a person who has fulfilled, not barely social duties, but
all kind of righteousness. That he might bring us to God - Now to his
gracious favour, hereafter to his blissful presence, by the same steps
of suffering and of glory. Being put to death in the flesh - As man. But
raised to life by the Spirit - Both by his own divine power, and by the
power of the Holy Ghost.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p22">19. By which Spirit he preached - Through the ministry of
Noah. To the spirits in prison - The unholy men before the flood, who
were then reserved by the justice of God, as in a prison, till he
executed the sentence upon them all; and are now also reserved to the
judgment of the great day.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p23">20. When the longsuffering of God waited - For an hundred
and twenty years; all the time the ark was preparing: during which Noah
warned them all to flee from the wrath to come.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p24">21. The antitype whereof - The thing typified by the ark,
even baptism, now saveth us - That is, through the water of baptism we
are saved from the sin which overwhelms the world as a flood: not,
indeed, the bare outward sign, but the inward grace; a divine
consciousness that both our persons and our actions are accepted through
him who died and rose again for us.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.iv-p25">22. Angels and authorities and powers - That is, all orders
both of angels and men.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="24.42%" prev="i.xxii.iv" next="i.xxii.vi" id="i.xxii.v">
<h3 id="i.xxii.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Pet. IV" id="i.xxii.v-p0.2" parsed="|1Pet|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.4" /> 

<p id="i.xxii.v-p1">1. Arm yourselves with the same mind - Which will be armour
of proof against all your enemies. For he that hath suffered in the
flesh - That hath so suffered as to be thereby made inwardly and truly
conformable to the sufferings of Christ. Hath ceased from sin - Is
delivered from it.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p2">2. That ye may no longer live in the flesh - Even in this
mortal body. To the desires of men - Either your own or those of others.
These are various; but the will of God is one.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p3">3. Revellings, banquetings - Have these words any meaning
now? They had, seventeen hundred years ago. Then the former meant,
meetings to eat; meetings, the direct end of which was, to please the
taste: the latter, meetings to drink: both of which Christians then
ranked with abominable idolatries.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p4">4. The same - As ye did once. Speaking evil of you - As
proud, singular, silly, wicked and the like.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p5">5. Who shall give account - Of this, as well as all their
other ways. To him who is ready - So faith represents him now.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p6">6. For to this end was the gospel preached - Ever since it
was given to Adam. To them that are now dead - In their several
generations. That they might be judged - That though they were judged.
In the flesh according to the manner of men - With rash, unrighteous
judgment. They might live according to the will and word of God, in the
Spirit; the soul renewed after his image.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p7">7. But the end of all things - And so of their wrongs, and
your sufferings. Is at hand: be ye therefore sober, and watch unto
prayer - Temperance helps watchfulness, and both of them help prayer.
Watch, that ye may pray; and pray, that ye may watch.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p8">8. Love covereth a multitude of sins - Yea, "love covereth
all things." He that loves another, covers his faults, how many soever
they be. He turns away his own eyes from them; and, as far as is
possible, hides them from others. And he continually prays that all the
sinner's iniquities may be forgiven and his sins covered. Meantime the
God of love measures to him with the same measure into his bosom.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p9">9. One to another - Ye that are of different towns or
countries. Without murmuring - With all cheerfulness. <scripRef passage="Prov. x. 12" id="i.xxii.v-p9.1" parsed="|Prov|10|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.10.12">Prov. x, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p10">10. As every one hath received a gift - Spiritual or
temporal, ordinary or extraordinary, although the latter seems primarily
intended. So minister it one to another - Employ it for the common good.
As good stewards of the manifold grace of God--The talents wherewith
his free love has intrusted you.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p11">11. If any man speak, let him - In his whole conversation,
public and private. Speak as the oracles of God - Let all his words be
according to this pattern, both as to matter and manner, more especially
in public. By this mark we may always know who are, so far, the true or
false prophets. The oracles of God teach that men should repent,
believe, obey. He that treats of faith and leaves out repentance, or
does not enjoin practical holiness to believers, does not speak as the
oracles of God: he does not preach Christ, let him think as highly of
himself as he will. If any man minister - Serve his brother in love,
whether in spirituals or temporals. Let him minister as of the ability
which God giveth - That is, humbly and diligently, ascribing all his
power to God, and using it with his might. Whose is the glory - of his
wisdom, which teaches us to speak. And the might - Which enables us to
act.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p12">12. Wonder not at the burning which is among you - This is
the literal meaning of the expression. It seems to include both
martyrdom itself, which so frequently was by fire, and all the other
sufferings joined with, or previous to, it; which is permitted by the
wisdom of God for your trial. Be not surprised at this.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p13">13. But as ye partake of the sufferings of Christ - chap.
1, while ye suffer for his sake, rejoice in hope of more abundant glory.
For the measure of glory answers the measure of suffering; and much more
abundantly.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p14">14. If ye are reproached for Christ - Reproaches and cruel
mockings were always one part of their sufferings. The Spirit of glory
and of God resteth upon you - The same Spirit which was upon Christ, <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 18" id="i.xxii.v-p14.1" parsed="|Luke|4|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.18">Luke iv, 18</scripRef>. He is here termed, the Spirit of glory, conquering all
reproach and shame, and the Spirit of God, whose Son, Jesus Christ is.
On their part he is blasphemed, but on your part he is glorified - That
is, while they are blaspheming Christ, you glorify him in the midst of
your sufferings, chap. 16.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p15">15. Let none of you deservedly suffer, as an evildoer - In
any kind.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p16">16. Let him glorify God - Who giveth him the honour so to
suffer, and so great a reward for suffering.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p17">17. The time is come for judgment to begin at the house of
God - God first visits his church, and that both in justice and mercy.
What shall the end be of them that obey not the gospel - How terribly
will he visit them! The judgments which are milder at the beginning,
grow more and more severe. But good men, having already sustained their
part, are only spectators of the miseries of the wicked.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p18">18. If the righteous scarcely be saved - Escape with the
utmost difficulty. Where shall the ungodly - The man who knows not God.
And the open sinner appear - In that day of vengeance. The salvation
here primarily spoken of is of a temporal nature. But we may apply the
words to eternal things, and then they are still more awful. <scripRef passage="Prov. xi. 31" id="i.xxii.v-p18.1" parsed="|Prov|11|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.11.31">Prov. xi, 31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.v-p19">19. Let them that suffer according to the will of God -
Both for a good cause, and in a right spirit. Commit to him their souls
- (Whatever becomes of the body) as a sacred depositum. In well doing -
Be this your care, to do and suffer well: He will take care of the rest.
As unto a faithful Creator - In whose truth, love, and power, ye may
safely trust.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="24.52%" prev="i.xxii.v" next="i.xxiii" id="i.xxii.vi">
<h3 id="i.xxii.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Pet. V" id="i.xxii.vi-p0.2" parsed="|1Pet|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.5" /> 

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p1">1. I who am a fellow-elder - So the first though not the
head of the apostles appositely and modestly styles himself. And a
witness of the sufferings of Christ - Having seen him suffer, and now
suffering for him.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p2">2. Feed the flock - Both by doctrine and discipline. Not by
constraint - Unwillingly, as a burden. Not for filthy gain - Which, if
it be the motive of acting, is filthy beyond expression. O consider
this, ye that leave one flock and go to another, merely because there is
more gain, a large salary! Is it not astonishing that men can see no
harm in this? that it is not only practiced, but avowed, all over the
nation?</p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p3">3. Neither as lording over the heritage - Behaving in a
haughty, domineering manner, as though you had dominion over their
conscience. The word translated heritage, is, literally, the portions.
There is one flock under the one chief Shepherd; but many portions of
this, under many pastors. But being examples to the flock - This
procures the most ready and free obedience.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p4">5. Ye younger, be subject to the elder - In years. And be
all - Elder or younger. Subject to each other - Let every one be ready,
upon all occasions, to give up his own will. Be clothed with
humility-Bind it on, (so the word signifies,) so that no force may be
able to tear it from you. <scripRef passage="James iv. 6" id="i.xxii.vi-p4.1" parsed="|Jas|4|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.4.6">James iv,
6</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Prov. iii. 34" id="i.xxii.vi-p4.2" parsed="|Prov|3|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.3.34">Prov. iii,
34</scripRef></p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p5">6. The hand of God - Is in all troubles.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p6">7. Casting all your care upon him - In every want or
pressure.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p7">8. But in the mean time watch. There is a close connection
between this, and the duly casting our care upon him. How deeply had St.
Peter himself suffered for want of watching! Be vigilant - As if he had
said, Awake, and keep awake. Sleep no more: be this your care. As a
roaring lion - Full of rage. Seeking - With all subtilty likewise. Whom
he may devour or swallow up - Both soul and body.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p8">9. Be the more steadfast, as ye know the same kind of
afflictions are accomplished in - That is, suffered by, your brethren,
till the measure allotted them is filled up.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p9">10. Now the God of all grace - By which alone the whole
work is begun, continued, and finished in your soul. After ye have
suffered a while - A very little while compared with eternity. Himself -
Ye have only to watch and resist the devil: the rest God will perform.
Perfect - That no defect may remain. Stablish - That nothing may
overthrow you. Strengthen - That ye may conquer all adverse power. And
settle you - As an house upon a rock. So the apostle, being converted,
does now "strengthen his brethren."</p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p10">12. As I suppose - As I judge, upon good grounds, though
not by immediate inspiration. I have written - That is, sent my letter
by him. Adding my testimony - To that which ye before heard from Paul,
that this is the true gospel of the grace of God.</p>

<p id="i.xxii.vi-p11">13. The church that is at Babylon - Near which St. Peter
probably was, when he wrote this epistle. Elected together with you -
Partaking of the same faith with you. Mark - It seems the evangelist. My
son - Probably converted by St. Peter. And he had occasionally served
him, "as a son in the gospel."</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE SECOND EPISTLE GENERAL OF ST. PETER" progress="24.57%" prev="i.xxii.vi" next="i.xxiii.i" id="i.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2Pet" id="i.xxiii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xxiii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE SECOND EPISTLE GENERAL OF ST. PETER</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Second Peter" progress="24.58%" prev="i.xxiii" next="i.xxiii.ii" id="i.xxiii.i">

<p id="i.xxiii.i-p1">THE parts of this epistle, written not long before St.
Peter's death, and the destruction of Jerusalem, with the same design as
the former, are likewise three:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxiii.i-p2">I. The inscription, Chap. i.1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxiii.i-p3">II. A further stirring up of the minds of
true believers, in which,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxiii.i-p4">1. He exhorts them, having received the
precious gift, to give all diligence to "grow in grace," 3-11</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxiii.i-p5">2. To this he incites them,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiii.i-p6">1. From the firmness of true teachers,
12-21</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiii.i-p7">2. From the wickedness of false teachers,
ii.1-22</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxiii.i-p8">3. He guards them against impostors,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiii.i-p9">1. By confuting their error iii.1-9</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiii.i-p10">2. By describing the great day, adding
suitable exhortations, 10-14</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxiii.i-p11">III. The conclusion, in which he,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxiii.i-p12">1. Declares his agreement with St. Paul, 15,
16</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxiii.i-p13">2. Repeats the sum of the epistle, 17</p>
<h2 id="i.xxiii.i-p13.1">2nd PETER</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="24.59%" prev="i.xxiii.i" next="i.xxiii.iii" id="i.xxiii.ii">
<h3 id="i.xxiii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Pet. I" id="i.xxiii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|2Pet|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.1" /> 

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p1">1. To them that have obtained - Not by their own works, but
by the free grace of God. Like precious faith with us - The apostles.
The faith of those who have not seen, being equally precious with that
of those who saw our Lord in the flesh. Through the righteousness - Both
active and passive. Of our God and saviour - It is this alone by which
the justice of God is satisfied, and for the sake of which he gives this
precious faith.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p2">2. Through the divine, experimental knowledge of God and of
Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p3">3. As his divine power has given us all things - There is a
wonderful cheerfulness in this exordium, which begins with the
exhortation itself. That pertain to life and godliness - To the present,
natural life, and to the continuance and increase of spiritual life.
Through that divine knowledge of him - Of Christ. Who hath called us by
- His own glorious power, to eternal glory, as the end; by Christian
virtue or fortitude, as the means.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p4">4. Through which - Glory and fortitude. He hath given us
exceeding great, and inconceivably precious promises - Both the promises
and the things promised, which follow in their due season, that,
sustained and encouraged by the promises, we may obtain all that he has
promised. That, having escaped the manifold corruption which is in the
world - From that fruitful fountain, evil desire. Ye may become
partakers of the divine nature - Being renewed in the image of God, and
having communion with them, so as to dwell in God and God in you.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p5">5. For this very reason - Because God hath given you so
great blessings. Giving all diligence - It is a very uncommon word which
we render giving. It literally signifies, bringing in by the by, or over
and above: implying, that good works the work; yet not unless we are
diligent. Our diligence is to follow the gift of God, and is followed by
an increase of all his gifts. Add to - And in all the other gifts of
God. Superadd the latter, without losing the former. The Greek word
properly means lead up, as in dance, one of these after the other, in a
beautiful order. Your faith, that "evidence of things not seen," termed
before "the knowledge of God and of Christ," the root of all Christian
graces. Courage - Whereby ye may conquer all enemies and difficulties,
and execute whatever faith dictates. In this most beautiful connection,
each preceding grace leads to the following; each following, tempers and
perfects the preceding. They are set down in the order of nature, rather
than the order of time. For though every grace bears a relation to every
other, yet here they are so nicely ranged, that those which have the
closest dependence on each other are placed together. And to your
courage knowledge - Wisdom, teaching how to exercise it on all
occasions.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p6">6. And to your knowledge temperance; and to your temperance
patience - Bear and forbear; sustain and abstain; deny yourself and take
up your cross daily. The more knowledge you have, the more renounce your
own will; indulge yourself the less. "Knowledge puffeth up," and the
great boasters of knowledge (the Gnostics) were those that "turned the
grace of God into wantonness." But see that your knowledge be attended
with temperance. Christian temperance implies the voluntary abstaining
from all pleasure which does not lead to God. It extends to all things
inward and outward: the due government of every thought, as well as
affection. "It is using the world," so to use all outward, and so to
restrain all inward things, that they may become a means of what is
spiritual; a scaling ladder to ascend to what is above. Intemperance is
to abuse the world. He that uses anything below, looking no higher, and
getting no further, is intemperate. He that uses the creature only so as
to attain to more of the Creator, is alone temperate, and walks as
Christ himself walked. And to patience godliness - Its proper support: a
continual sense of God's presence and providence, and a filial fear of,
and confidence in, him; otherwise your patience may be pride, surliness,
stoicism; but not Christianity.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p7">7. And to godliness brotherly kindness - No sullenness,
sternness, moroseness: "sour godliness," so called, is of the devil. Of
Christian godliness it may always be said, "Mild, sweet, serene, and
tender is her mood, Nor grave with sternness, nor with lightness free:
Against example resolutely good, Fervent in zeal, and warm in charity."
And to brotherly kindness love - The pure and perfect love of God and of
all mankind. The apostle here makes an advance upon the preceding
article, brotherly kindness, which seems only to relate to the love of
Christians toward one another.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p8">8. For these being really in you - Added to your faith. And
abounding - Increasing more and more, otherwise we fall short. Make you
neither slothful nor unfruitful - Do not suffer you to be faint in your
mind, or without fruit in your lives. If there is less faithfulness,
less care and watchfulness, since we were pardoned, than there was
before, and less diligence, less outward obedience, than when we were
seeking remission of sin, we are both slothful and unfruitful in the
knowledge of Christ, that is, in the faith, which then cannot work by
love.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p9">9. But he that wanteth these - That does not add them to
his faith. Is blind - The eyes of his understanding are again closed. He
cannot see God, or his pardoning love. He has lost the evidence of
things not seen. Not able to see afar off - Literally, purblind. He has
lost sight of the precious promises: perfect love and heaven are equally
out of his sight. Nay, he cannot now see what himself once enjoyed.
Having, as it were, forgot the purification from his former sins -
Scarce knowing what he himself then felt, when his sins were
forgiven.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p10">10. Wherefore - Considering the miserable state of these
apostates. Brethren - St. Peter nowhere uses this appellation in either
of his epistles, but in this important exhortation. Be the more diligent
- By courage, knowledge, temperance, &amp;c. To make your calling and
election firm - God hath called you by his word and his Spirit; he hath
elected you, separated you from the world, through sanctification of the
Spirit. O cast not away these inestimable benefits! If ye are thus
diligent to make your election firm, ye shall never finally fall.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p11">11. For if ye do so, an entrance shall be ministered to you
abundantly into the everlasting kingdom - Ye shall go in full triumph to
glory.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p12">12. Wherefore - Since everlasting destruction attends your
sloth, everlasting glory your diligence, I will not neglect always to
remind you of these things - Therefore he wrote another, so soon after
the former, epistle. Though ye are established in the present truth -
That truth which I am now declaring.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p13">13. In this tabernacle - Or tent. How short is our abode in
the body! How easily does a believer pass out of it!</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p14">14. Even as the Lord Jesus showed me - In the manner which
had foretold, <scripRef passage="John xxi. 18" id="i.xxiii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|John|21|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.21.18">John xxi, 18</scripRef>, &amp;c. It is not improbable, he had also showed him that
the time was now drawing nigh.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p15">15. That ye may be able - By having this epistle among
you.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p16">16. These things are worthy to be always had in remembrance
For they are not cunningly devised fables - Like those common among the
heathens. While we made known to you the power and coming - That is, the
powerful coming of Christ in glory. But if what they advanced of Christ
was not true, if it was of their own invention, then to impose such a
lie on the world as it was, in the very nature of things, above all
human power to defend, and to do this at the expense of life and all
things only to enrage the whole world, Jews and gentiles, against them,
was no cunning, but was the greatest folly that men could have been
guilty of. But were eyewitnesses of his majesty - At his
transfiguration, which was a specimen of his glory at the last day.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p17">17. For he received divine honour and inexpressible glory -
Shining from heaven above the brightness of the sun. When there came
such a voice from the excellent glory - That is, from God the Father. <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 5" id="i.xxiii.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|17|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.5">Matt. xvii, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p18">18. And we - Peter, James, and John. St. John was still
alive. Being with him in the holy mount - Made so by that glorious
manifestation, as Mount Horeb was of old, <scripRef passage="Exod. iii. 4, 5" id="i.xxiii.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Exod|3|4|3|5" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3.4-Exod.3.5">Exod. iii, 4, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p19">19. And we - St. Peter here speaks in the name of all
Christians. Have the word of prophecy - The words of Moses, Isaiah, and
all the prophets, are one and the same word, every way consistent with
itself. St. Peter does not cite any particular passage, but speaks of
their entire testimony. More confirmed - By that display of his glorious
majesty. To which word ye do well that ye take heed, as to a lamp which
shone in a dark place - Wherein there was neither light nor window. Such
anciently was the whole world, except that little spot where this lamp
shone. Till the day should dawn - Till the full light of the gospel
should break through the darkness. As is the difference between the
light of a lamp and that of the day, such is that between the light of
the Old Testament and of the New. And the morning star - Jesus Christ, <scripRef passage="Rev. xxii. 16" id="i.xxiii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Rev|22|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.22.16">Rev. xxii, 16</scripRef>. Arise in your hearts - Be revealed in you.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p20">20. Ye do well, as knowing this, that no scripture prophecy
is of private interpretation - It is not any man's own word. It is God,
not the prophet himself, who thereby interprets things till then
unknown.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.ii-p21">21. For prophecy came not of old by the will of man - Of
any mere man whatever. But the holy men of God - Devoted to him, and set
apart by him for that purpose, spake and wrote. Being moved - Literally,
carried. They were purely passive therein.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="24.76%" prev="i.xxiii.ii" next="i.xxiii.iv" id="i.xxiii.iii">
<h3 id="i.xxiii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Pet. II" id="i.xxiii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|2Pet|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.2" /> 

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p1">1. But there were false prophets also - As well as true.
Among the people - Of Israel. Those that spake even the truth, when God
had not sent them; and also those that were truly sent of him, and yet
corrupted or softened their message, were false prophets. As there shall
be false - As well as true. Teachers among you, who will privately briny
in - Into the church. Destructive heresies - They first, by denying the
Lord, introduced destructive heresies, that is, divisions; or they
occasioned first these divisions, and then were given up to a reprobate
mind, even to deny the Lord that bought them. Either the heresies are
the effect of denying the Lord, or the denying the Lord was the
consequence of the heresies. Even denying - Both by their doctrine and
their works. The Lord that bought them - With his own blood. Yet these
very men perish everlastingly. Therefore Christ bought even them that
perish.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p2">2. The way of truth will be evil spoken of - By those who
blend all false and true Christians together.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p3">3. They will make merchandise of you - Only use you to gain
by you, as merchants do their wares. Whose judgment now of a long time
lingereth not - Was long ago determined, and will be executed speedily.
All sinners are adjudged to destruction; and God's punishing some proves
he will punish the rest.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p4">4. Cast them down to hell - The bottomless pit, a place of
unknown misery. Delivered them - Like condemned criminals to safe
custody, as if bound with the strongest chains in a dungeon of darkness,
to be reserved unto the judgment of the great day. Though still those
chains do not hinder their often walking up and down seeking whom they
may devour.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p5">5. And spared not the old, the antediluvian, world, but he
preserved Noah the eighth person - that is, Noah and seven others, a
preacher as well as practicer, of righteousness. Bringing a flood on the
world of the ungodly - Whose numbers stood them in no stead.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p6">9. It plainly appears, from these instances, that the Lord
knoweth, hath both wisdom and power and will, to deliver the godly out
of all temptations, and to punish the ungodly.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p7">10. Chiefly them that walk after the flesh - Corrupt
nature; particularly in the lust of uncleanness. And despise government
- The authority of their governors. Dignities - Persons in
authority.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p8">11. Whereas angels - When they appear before the Lord, <scripRef passage="Job i. 6" id="i.xxiii.iii-p8.1" parsed="|Job|1|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.1.6">Job i, 6</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Job ii. 1" id="i.xxiii.iii-p8.2" parsed="|Job|2|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.2.1">Job ii, 1</scripRef>, to give an account of what they have seen and done on the
earth.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p9">12. Savage as brute beasts - Several of which in the
present disordered state of the world, seem born to be taken and
destroyed.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p10">13. They count it pleasure to riot in the day time - They
glory in doing it in the face of the sun. They are spots in themselves,
blemishes to any church. Sporting themselves with their own deceivings -
Making a jest of those whom they deceive and even jesting while they are
deceiving their own souls.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p11">15. The way of Balaam the son of Bosor - So the Chaldeans
pronounced what the Jews termed Beor; namely, the way of covetousness.
Who loved - Earnestly desired, though he did not dare to take, the
reward of unrighteousness - The money which Balak would have given him
for cursing Israel.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p12">16. The beast - Though naturally dumb.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p13">17. Fountains and clouds promise water: so do these
promise, but do not perform.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p14">18. They ensnare in the desires of the flesh - Allowing
them to gratify some unholy desire. Those who were before entirely
escaped from the spirit, custom, and company of them that live in error
- In sin.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p15">19. While they promise them liberty - From needless
restraints and scruples; from the bondage of the law. Themselves are
slaves of corruption - Even sin, the vilest of all bondage.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p16">20. For if after they - Who are thus ensnared. Have escaped
the pollutions of the world - The sins which pollute all who know not
God. Through the knowledge of Christ - That is, through faith in him,
chap. i, 3. They are again entangled therein, and overcome, their last
state is worse than the first - More inexcusable, and causing a greater
damnation.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p17">21. The commandment - The whole law of God, once not only
delivered to their ears, but written in their hearts.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iii-p18">22. The dog, the sow - Such are all men in the sight of God
before they receive his grace, and after they have made shipwreck of the
faith. <scripRef passage="Prov. xxvi. 11" id="i.xxiii.iii-p18.1" parsed="|Prov|26|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.26.11">Prov. xxvi, 11</scripRef>.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="24.83%" prev="i.xxiii.iii" next="i.xxiv" id="i.xxiii.iv">
<h3 id="i.xxiii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Pet. III" id="i.xxiii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|2Pet|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.3" /> 

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p1">2, 3. Be the more mindful thereof, because ye know scoffers
will come first - Before the Lord comes. Walking after their own evil
desires - Here is the origin of the error, the root of libertinism. Do
we not see this eminently fulfilled?</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p2">4. Saying, Where is the promise of his coming - To judgment
(They do not even deign to name him.) We see no sign of any such thing.
For ever since the fathers - Our first ancestors. Fell asleep, all
things - Heaven. water, earth. Continue as they were from the beginning
of the creation - Without any such material change as might make us
believe they will ever end.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p3">5. For this they are willingly ignorant of - They do not
care to know or consider. That by the almighty word of God - Which
bounds the duration of all things, so that it cannot be either longer or
shorter. Of old - Before the flood. The aerial heavens were, and the
earth - Not as it is now, but standing out of the water and in the water
- Perhaps the interior globe of earth was fixed in the midst of the
great deep, the abyss of water; the shell or exterior globe standing out
of the water, covering the great deep. This, or some other great and
manifest difference between the original and present constitution of the
terraqueous globe, seems then to have been so generally known, that St.
Peter charges their ignorance of it totally upon their wilfulness.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p4">6. Through which - Heaven and earth, the windows of heaven
being opened, and the fountains of the great deep broken up. The world
that then was - The whole antediluvian race. Being overflowed with
water, perished - And the heavens and earth themselves, though they did
not perish, yet underwent a great change. So little ground have these
scoffers for saying that all things continue as they were from the
creation.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p5">7. But the heavens and the earth, that are now - Since the
flood. Are reserved unto fire at the day wherein God will judge the
world, and punish the ungodly with everlasting destruction.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p6">8. But be not ye ignorant - Whatever they are. Of this one
thing - Which casts much light on the point in hand. That one day is
with the Lord as a thousand years, and a thousand years as one day -
Moses had said, <scripRef passage="Psalm xc. 4" id="i.xxiii.iv-p6.1" parsed="|Ps|90|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.90.4">Psalm xc, 4</scripRef>, "A thousand years in thy sight are as one day;" which St.
Peter applies with regard to the last day, so as to denote both his
eternity, whereby he exceeds all measure of time in his essence and in
his operation; his knowledge, to which all things past or to come are
present every moment; his power, which needs no long delay, in order to
bring its work to perfection; and his longsuffering, which excludes all
impatience of expectation, and desire of making haste. One day is with
the Lord as a thousand years - That is, in one day, in one moment he can
do the work of a thousand years. Therefore he "is not slow:" he is
always equally ready to fulfil his promise. And a thousand years are as
one day - That is, no delay is long to God. A thousand years are as one
day to the eternal God. Therefore "he is longsuffering:" he gives us
space for repentance, without any inconvenience to himself. In a word,
with God time passes neither slower nor swifter than is suitable to him
and his economy; nor can there be any reason why it should be necessary
for him either to delay or hasten the end of all things. How can we
comprehend this? If we could comprehend it, St. Peter needed not to have
added, with the Lord.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p7">9. The Lord is not slow - As if the time fixed for it were
past. Concerning his promise - Which shall surely be fulfilled in its
season. But is longsuffering towards us - Children of men. Not willing
that any soul, which he hath made should perish.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p8">10. But the day of the Lord will come as a thief -
Suddenly, unexpectedly. In which the heavens shall pass away with a
great noise - Surprisingly expressed by the very sound of the original
word. The elements shall melt with fervent heat - The elements seem to
mean, the sun, moon, and stars; not the four, commonly so called; for
air and water cannot melt, and the earth is mentioned immediately after.
The earth and all the works - Whether of nature or art. That are therein
shall be burned up - And has not God already abundantly provided for
this?</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiii.iv-p9">1. By the stores of subterranean fire which
are so frequently bursting out at Aetna, Vesuvius, Hecla, and many other
burning mountains.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiii.iv-p10">2. By the ethereal (vulgarly called
electrical) fire, diffused through the whole globe; which, if the secret
chain that now binds it up were loosed, would immediately dissolve the
whole frame of nature.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiii.iv-p11">3. By comets, one of which, if it touch the
earth in its course toward the sun, must needs strike it into that abyss
of fire; if in its return from the sun, when it is heated, as a great
man computes, two thousand times hotter than a red-hot cannonball, it
must destroy all vegetables and animals long before their contact, and
soon after burn it up.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p12">11. Seeing then that all these things are dissolved - To
the eye of faith it appears as done already. All these things -
Mentioned before; all that are included in that scriptural expression,
"the heavens and the earth;" that is, the universe. On the fourth day
God made the stars, <scripRef passage="Gen. i. 16" id="i.xxiii.iv-p12.1" parsed="|Gen|1|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.1.16">Gen. i,
16</scripRef>, which will be dissolved together with the earth. They are
deceived, therefore, who restrain either the history of the creation, or
this description of the destruction, of the world to the earth and lower
heavens; imagining the stars to be more ancient than the earth, and to
survive it. Both the dissolution and renovation are ascribed, not to the
one heaven which surrounds the earth, but to the heavens in general,
ver. 10, 13, without any restriction or limitation. What persons ought
ye to be in all holy conversation - With men. And godliness - Toward
your Creator.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p13">12. Hastening on - As it were by your earnest desires and
fervent prayers. The coming of the day of God - Many myriads of days he
grants to men: one, the last, is the day of God himself.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p14">13. We look for new heavens and a new earth - Raised as it
were out of the ashes of the old; we look for an entire new state of
things. Wherein dwelleth righteousness - Only righteous spirits. How
great a mystery!</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p15">14. labour that whenever he cometh ye may be found in peace
- May meet him without terror, being sprinkled with his blood, and
sanctified by his Spirit, so as to be without spot and blameless. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxv. 17" id="i.xxiii.iv-p15.1" parsed="|Isa|65|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.65.17">Isaiah lxv, 17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxvi. 22" id="i.xxiii.iv-p15.2" parsed="|Isa|66|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.66.22">Isaiah lxvi, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p16">15. And account the longsuffering of the Lord salvation -
Not only designed to lead men to repentance, but actually conducing
thereto: a precious means of saving many more souls. As our beloved
brother Paul also hath written to you - This refers not only to the
single sentence preceding, but to all that went before. St. Paul had
written to the same effect concerning the end of the world, in several
parts of his epistles, and particularly in his Epistle to the Hebrews. <scripRef passage="Rom. ii. 4" id="i.xxiii.iv-p16.1" parsed="|Rom|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.2.4">Rom. ii, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p17">16. As also in all his epistles - St. Peter wrote this a
little before his own and St. Paul's martyrdom. St. Paul therefore had
now written all his epistles; and even from this expression we may learn
that St. Peter had read them all, perhaps sent to him by St. Paul
himself. Nor was he at all disgusted by what St. Paul had written
concerning him in the Epistle to the Galatians. Speaking of these things
- Namely, of the coming of our Lord, delayed through his longsuffering,
and of the circumstances preceding and accompanying it. Which things the
unlearned - They who are not taught of God. And the unstable - Wavering,
double-minded, unsettled men. Wrest - As though Christ would not come.
As they do also the other scriptures - Therefore St. Paul's writings were
now part of the scriptures. To their own destruction - But that some use
the scriptures ill, is no reason why others should not use them at
all.</p>

<p id="i.xxiii.iv-p18">18. But grow in grace - That is, in every Christian temper.
There may be, for a time, grace without growth; as there may be natural
life without growth. But such sickly life, of soul or body, will end in
death, and every day draw nigher to it. Health is the means of both
natural and spiritual growth. If the remaining evil of our fallen nature
be not daily mortified, it will, like an evil humour in the body,
destroy the whole man. But "if ye through the Spirit do mortify the
deeds of the body," (only so far as we do this,) "ye shall live" the
life of faith, holiness, happiness. The end and design of grace being
purchased and bestowed on us, is to destroy the image of the earthy, and
restore us to that of the heavenly. And so far as it does this, it truly
profits us; and also makes way for more of the heavenly gift, that we
may at last be filled with all the fulness of God. The strength and
well-being of a Christian depend on what his soul feeds on, as the
health of the body depends on whatever we make our daily food. If we
feed on what is according to our nature, we grow; if not, we pine away
and die. The soul is of the nature of God, and nothing but what is
according to his holiness can agree with it. Sin, of every kind, starves
the soul, and makes it consume away. Let us not try to invert the order
of God in his new creation: we shall only deceive ourselves. It is easy
to forsake the will of God, and follow our own; but this will bring
leanness into the soul. It is easy to satisfy ourselves without being
possessed of the holiness and happiness of the gospel. It is easy to
call these frames and feelings, and then to oppose faith to one and
Christ to the other. Frames (allowing the expression) are no other than
heavenly tempers, "the mind that was in Christ." Feelings are the divine
consolations of the Holy Ghost shed abroad in the heart of him that
truly believes. And wherever faith is, and wherever Christ is, there are
these blessed frames and feelings. If they are not in us, it is a sure
sign that though the wilderness became a pool, the pool is become a
wilderness again. And in the knowledge of Christ - That is, in faith,
the root of all. To him be the glory to the day of eternity - An
expression naturally flowing from that sense which the apostle had felt
in his soul throughout this whole chapter. Eternity is a day without
night, without interruption, without end.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE FIRST EPISTLE OF ST. JOHN" progress="25.01%" prev="i.xxiii.iv" next="i.xxiv.i" id="i.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1John" id="i.xxiv-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xxiv-p0.2">NOTES ON THE FIRST EPISTLE OF ST. JOHN</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to First John" progress="25.01%" prev="i.xxiv" next="i.xxiv.ii" id="i.xxiv.i">

<p id="i.xxiv.i-p1">THE great similitude, or rather sameness, both of spirit
and expression, which runs through St. John's Gospel and all his
epistles, is a clear evidence of their being written by the same person.
In this epistle he speaks not to any particular church, but to all the
Christians of that age; and in them to the whole Christian church in all
succeeding ages. Some have apprehended that it is not easy to discern
the scope and method of this epistle. But if we examine it with
simplicity, these may readily be discovered. St. John in this letter, or
rather tract, (for he was present with part of those to whom he wrote,)
has this apparent aim, to confirm the happy and holy communion of the
faithful with God and Christ, by describing the marks of that blessed
state. The parts of it are three:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxiv.i-p2">I. The preface, Chap. i.1-4</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxiv.i-p3">II. The tract itself, 5- v.1-12</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxiv.i-p4">III. The conclusion, 13-21 In the preface he
shows the authority of his own preaching and writing, and expressly
points out, verse 3, the design of his present writing. To the preface
exactly answers the conclusion, more largely explaining the same design,
and recapitulating those marks, by we know thrice repeated, v. 18-20.
The tract itself has two parts, treating,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxiv.i-p5">I. Severally,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiv.i-p6">1. Of communion with the Father, i. 5-10</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiv.i-p7">2. Of communion with the Son, ii. 1-12 With a
distinct application to fathers, young men, and little children, 13-27
Whereto is annexed an exhortation to abide in him, 28- iii. 1-24 That
the fruit of his manifestation in the flesh may extend to his
manifestation in glory.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxiv.i-p8">3. Of the confirmation and fruit of this
abiding through the Spirit, iv. 1-21</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxiv.i-p9">II. Conjointly, Of the testimony of the
Father, and Son, and Spirit: on which faith in Christ, the being born of
God, love to God and his children, the keeping his commandments and
victory over the world, are founded, v. 1-12 The parts frequently begin
and end alike. Sometimes there is an allusion in a preceding part, and a
recapitulation in the subsequent. Each part treats of a benefit from
God, and the duty of the faithful derived therefrom by the most natural
inferences.</p>
<h2 id="i.xxiv.i-p9.1">1st JOHN</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="25.05%" prev="i.xxiv.i" next="i.xxiv.iii" id="i.xxiv.ii">
<h3 id="i.xxiv.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 John I" id="i.xxiv.ii-p0.2" parsed="|1John|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.1" /> 

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p1">1. That which was - Here means, He which was the Word
himself; afterwards it means, that which they had heard from him. Which
was - Namely, with the Father, ver. 2, before he was manifested. From
the beginning - This phrase is sometimes used in a limited sense; but
here it properly means from eternity, being equivalent with, "in the
beginning," <scripRef passage="John i. 1" id="i.xxiv.ii-p1.1" parsed="|John|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.1">John i, 1</scripRef>. That which we - The apostles. Have not only heard, but seen
with our eyes, which we have beheld - Attentively considered on various
occasions. Of the Word of life - He is termed the Word, <scripRef passage="John i. 1" id="i.xxiv.ii-p1.2" parsed="|John|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.1">John i, 1</scripRef>; the Life, <scripRef passage="John i. 4" id="i.xxiv.ii-p1.3" parsed="|John|1|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.4">John i, 4</scripRef>; as he is the living Word of God, who, with the Father and
the Spirit, is the fountain of life to all creatures, particularly of
spiritual and eternal life.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p2">2. For the life - The living Word. Was manifested - In the
flesh, to our very senses. And we testify and declare - We testify by
declaring, by preaching, and writing, <scripRef passage="1 John i. 3, 4" id="i.xxiv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|1John|1|3|1|4" osisRef="Bible:1John.1.3-1John.1.4">1 John i, 3, 4</scripRef>. Preaching lays the foundation, <scripRef passage="1 John i. 5" id="i.xxiv.ii-p2.2" parsed="|1John|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.1.5">1 John i, 5</scripRef>-x, writing builds there on. To you - Who have not seen. The
eternal life - Which always was, and afterward appeared to us. This is
mentioned in the beginning of the epistle. In the end of it is mentioned
the same eternal life, which we shall always enjoy.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p3">3. That which we have seen and heard - Of him and from him.
Declare we to you - For this end. That ye also may have fellowship with
us - May enjoy the same fellowship which we enjoy. And truly our
fellowship - Whereby he is in us and we in him. Is with the Father and
with the son - Of the Holy Ghost he speaks afterwards.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p4">4. That your joy may be full - So our Lord also, <scripRef passage="John xv. 11; xvi. 22" id="i.xxiv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|John|15|11|0|0;|John|16|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.15.11 Bible:John.16.22">John xv, 11; xvi,
22</scripRef>. There is a joy of hope, a joy of faith, and a joy of love.
Here the joy of faith is directly intended. It is a concise expression.
Your joy - That is, your faith and the joy arising from it: but it
likewise implies the joy of hope and love.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p5">5. And this is the sum of the message which we have heard
of him - The Son of God. That God is light - The light of wisdom, love,
holiness, glory. What light is to the natural eye, that God is to the
spiritual eye. And in him is no darkness at all - No contrary principle.
He is pure, unmixed light.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p6">6. If we say - Either with our tongue, or in our heart, if
we endeavour to persuade either ourselves or others. We have fellowship
with him, while we walk, either inwardly or outwardly, in darkness - In
sin of any kind. We do not the truth - Our actions prove, that the truth
is not in us.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p7">7. But if we walk in the light - In all holiness. As God is
(a deeper word than walk, and more worthy of God) in the light, then we
may truly say, we have fellowship one with another - We who have seen,
and you who have not seen, do alike enjoy that fellowship with God. The
imitation of God being the only sure proof of our having fellowship with
him. And the blood of Jesus Christ his Son - With the grace purchased
thereby. Cleanseth us from all sin - Both original and actual, taking
away all the guilt and all the power.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p8">8. If we say - Any child of man, before his blood has
cleansed us. We have no sin - To be cleansed from, instead of confessing
our sins, <scripRef passage="1 John i. 9" id="i.xxiv.ii-p8.1" parsed="|1John|1|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.1.9">1 John i, 9</scripRef>, the truth is not in us - Neither in our mouth nor in our
heart.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p9">9. But if with a penitent and believing heart, we confess
our sins, he is faithful - Because he had promised this blessing, by the
unanimous voice of all his prophets. Just - Surely then he will punish:
no; for this very reason he will pardon. This may seem strange; but upon
the evangelical principle of atonement and redemption, it is undoubtedly
true; because, when the debt is paid, or the purchase made, it is the
part of equity to cancel the bond, and consign over the purchased
possession. Both to forgive us our sins - To take away all the guilt of
them. And to cleanse us from all unrighteousness - To purify our souls
from every kind and every degree of it.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.ii-p10">10. Yet still we are to retain, even to our lives' end, a
deep sense of our past sins. Still if we say, we have not sinned, we
make him a liar - Who saith, all have sinned. And his word is not in us
- We do not receive it; we give it no place in our hearts.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="25.12%" prev="i.xxiv.ii" next="i.xxiv.iv" id="i.xxiv.iii">
<h3 id="i.xxiv.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 John II" id="i.xxiv.iii-p0.2" parsed="|1John|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.2" /> 

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p1">1. My beloved children - So the apostle frequently
addresses the whole body of Christians. It is a term of tenderness and
endearment, used by our Lord himself to his disciples, <scripRef passage="John xiii. 33" id="i.xxiv.iii-p1.1" parsed="|John|13|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.13.33">John xiii, 33</scripRef>. And perhaps many to whom St. John now wrote were converted
by his ministry. It is a different word from that which is translated
"little children," in several parts of the epistle, to distinguish it
from which, it is here rendered beloved children. I write these things
to you, that ye may not sin - Thus he guards them beforehand against
abusing the doctrine of reconciliation. All the words, institutions, and
judgments of God are levelled against sin, either that it may not be
committed, or that it may be abolished. But if any one sin - Let him not
lie in sin, despairing of help. We have an advocate - We have for our
advocate, not a mean person, but him of whom it was said, "This is my
beloved son." Not a guilty person, who stands in need of pardon for
himself; but Jesus Christ the righteous; not a mere petitioner, who
relies purely upon liberality, but one that has merited, fully merited,
whatever he asks.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p2">2. And he is the propitiation - The atoning sacrifice by
which the wrath of God is appeased. For our sins - Who believe. And not
for ours only, but also for the sins of the whole world - Just as wide
as sin extends, the propitiation extends also.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p3">3. And hereby we know that we truly and savingly know him -
As he is the advocate, the righteous, the propitiation. If we keep his
commandments - Particularly those of faith and love.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p4">5. But whoso keepeth his word - His commandments. Verily in
him the love of God - Reconciled to us through Christ. Is perfected - Is
perfectly known. Hereby - By our keeping his word. We know that we are
in him - So is the tree known by its fruits. To "know him," to be "in
him," to "abide in him," are nearly synonymous terms; only with a
gradation, - knowledge, communion, constancy.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p5">6. He that saith he abideth in him - which implies a
durable state; a constant, lasting knowledge of, and communion with,
him. Ought himself - Otherwise they are vain words. So to walk, even as
he walked - In the world. As he, are words that frequently occur in this
epistle. Believers having their hearts full of him, easily supply his
name.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p6">7. When I speak of keeping his word, I write not a new
commandment - I do not speak of any new one. But the old commandment,
which ye had - Even from your forefathers.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p7">8. Again, I do write a new commandment to you - Namely,
with regard to loving one another. A commandment which, though it also
was given long ago, yet is truly new in him and in you. It was
exemplified in him, and is now fulfilled by you, in such a manner as it
never was before. For there is no comparison between the state of the
Old Testament believers, and that which ye now enjoy: the darkness of
that dispensation is passed away; and Christ the true light now shineth
in your hearts.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p8">9. He that saith he is in the light - In Christ, united to
him. And hateth his brother - The very name shows the love due to him.
Is in darkness until now - Void of Christ, and of all true light.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p9">10. He that loveth his brother - For Christ's sake. Abideth
in the light - Of God. And there is no occasion of stumbling in him -
Whereas he that hates his brother is an occasion of stumbling to
himself. He stumbles against himself, and against all things within and
without; while he that loves his brother, has a free, disencumbered
journey.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p10">11. He that hateth his brother - And he must hate, if he
does not love him: there is no medium. Is in darkness - In sin,
perplexity, entanglement. He walketh in darkness, and knoweth not that
he is in the high road to hell.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p11">12. I have written to you, beloved children - Thus St. John
bespeaks all to whom he writes. But from the thirteenth to <scripRef passage="1 John ii. 13-27" id="i.xxiv.iii-p11.1" parsed="|1John|2|13|2|27" osisRef="Bible:1John.2.13-1John.2.27">1 John ii, 13-27</scripRef> the twenty-seventh verse, he divides them particularly into
"fathers," "young men," and "little children." Because your sins are
forgiven you - As if he had said, This is the sum of what I have now
written. He then proceeds to other things, which are built upon this
foundation.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p12">13. The address to spiritual fathers, young men, and little
children is first proposed in this verse, wherein he says, I write to
you, fathers: I write to you, young men: I write to you, little
children: and then enlarged upon; in doing which he says, "I have
written to you, fathers," <scripRef passage="1 John ii. 14" id="i.xxiv.iii-p12.1" parsed="|1John|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.2.14">1 John ii,
14</scripRef>. "I have written to you, young men," 1 <scripRef passage="John ii. 14-17" id="i.xxiv.iii-p12.2" parsed="|John|2|14|2|17" osisRef="Bible:John.2.14-John.2.17">John ii, 14-17</scripRef>. "I have written to you, little children," <scripRef passage="1 John ii. 18-27" id="i.xxiv.iii-p12.3" parsed="|1John|2|18|2|27" osisRef="Bible:1John.2.18-1John.2.27">1 John ii, 18-27</scripRef>. Having finished his address to each, he returns to all
together, whom he again terms, (as <scripRef passage="1 John ii. 12" id="i.xxiv.iii-p12.4" parsed="|1John|2|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.2.12">1 John ii, 12</scripRef>,) "beloved children." Fathers, ye have known him that is
from the beginning - We have known the eternal God, in a manner wherein
no other, even true believers, know him. Young men, ye have overcome the
wicked one - In many battles, by the power of faith. Little children, ye
have known the Father - As your Father, though ye have not yet overcome,
by the Spirit witnessing with your Spirit, that ye are the children of
God."</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p13">14. I have written to you, fathers - As if he had said,
Observe well what I but now wrote. He speaks very briefly and modestly
to these, who needed not much to be said to them, as having that deep
acquaintance with God which comprises all necessary knowledge. Young
men, ye are strong - In faith. And the word of God abideth in you -
Deeply rooted in your hearts, whereby ye have often foiled your great
adversary.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p14">15. To you all, whether fathers, young men, or little
children, I say, Love not the world - Pursue your victory by overcoming
the world. If any man love the world - Seek happiness in visible things,
he does not love God.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p15">16. The desire of the flesh - Of the pleasure of the
outward senses, whether of the taste, smell, or touch. The desire of the
eye - Of the pleasures of imagination, to which the eye chiefly is
subservient; of that internal sense whereby we relish whatever is grand,
new, or beautiful. The pride of life - All that pomp in clothes, houses,
furniture, equipage, manner of living, which generally procure honour
from the bulk of mankind, and so gratify pride and vanity. It therefore
directly includes the desire of praise, and, remotely, covetousness. All
these desires are not from God, but from the prince of this world.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p16">17. The world passeth away, and the desire thereof - That
is, all that can gratify those desires passeth away with it. But he that
doeth the will of God - That loves God, not the world. Abideth - In the
enjoyment of what he loves, forever.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p17">18. Little children, it is the last time - The last
dispensation of grace, that which is to continue to the end of time, is
begun. Ye have heard that antichrist cometh - Under the term antichrist,
or the spirit of antichrist, he includes all false teachers and enemies
to the truth; yea, whatever doctrines or men are contrary to Christ. It
seems to have been long after this that the name of antichrist was
appropriated to that grand adversary of Christ, the man of sin, <scripRef passage="2 Thess. ii. 3" id="i.xxiv.iii-p17.1" parsed="|2Thess|2|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Thess.2.3">2 Thess. ii, 3</scripRef> Antichrist, in St. John's sense, that is, antichristianism,
has been spreading from his time till now; and will do so, till that
great adversary arises, and is destroyed by Christ's coming.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p18">19. They were not of us - When they went; their hearts were
before departed from God, otherwise, they would have continued with us:
but they went out, that they might be made manifest - That is, this was
made manifest by their going out.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p19">20. But ye have an anointing - A chrism; perhaps so termed
in opposition to the name of antichrist; an inward teaching from the
Holy Ghost, whereby ye know all things - Necessary for your preservation
from these seducers, and for your eternal salvation. St. John here but
just touches upon the Holy Ghost, of whom he speaks more largely, chap.
iii, 24; iv, 13; v, 6.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p20">21. I have written - Namely, <scripRef passage="1 John ii. 13" id="i.xxiv.iii-p20.1" parsed="|1John|2|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.2.13">1 John ii, 13</scripRef>. To you because ye know the truth - That is, to confirm you
in the knowledge ye have already. Ye know that no lie is of the truth -
That all the doctrines of these antichrists are irreconcilable to
it.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p21">22. Who is that liar - Who is guilty of that lying, but he
who denies that truth which is the sum of all Christianity? That Jesus
is the Christ; that he is the Son of God; that he came in the flesh, is
one undivided truth. and he that denies any part of this, in effect
denies the whole. He is antichrist - And the spirit of antichrist, who
in denying the Son denies the Father also.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p22">23. Whosoever denieth the eternal Son of God, he hath not
communion with the Father; but he that truly and believingly
acknowledgeth the Son, hath communion with the Father also.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p23">24. If that truth concerning the Father and the Son, which
ye have heard from the beginning, abide fixed and rooted in you, ye also
shall abide in that happy communion with the Son and the Father.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p24">25. He - The Son. Hath promised us - If we abide in
him.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p25">26. These things - From <scripRef passage="1 John ii. 21" id="i.xxiv.iii-p25.1" parsed="|1John|2|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.2.21">1
John ii, 21</scripRef>. I have written to you - St. John, according to his custom,
begins and ends with the same form, and having finished a kind of
parenthesis, <scripRef passage="1 John ii. 20-26" id="i.xxiv.iii-p25.2" parsed="|1John|2|20|2|26" osisRef="Bible:1John.2.20-1John.2.26">1 John ii,
20-26</scripRef>, continues, ii, 27, what he said in the twentieth verse,
concerning them that would seduce you.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p26">27. Ye need not that any should teach you, save as that
anointing teacheth you - Which is always the same, always consistent
with itself. But this does not exclude our need of being taught by them
who partake of the same anointing. Of all things - Which it is necessary
for you to know. And is no lie - Like that which antichrist teaches. Ye
shall abide in him - This is added both by way of comfort and of
exhortation. The whole discourse, from verse 18 to this, <scripRef passage="1 John ii. 18-27" id="i.xxiv.iii-p26.1" parsed="|1John|2|18|2|27" osisRef="Bible:1John.2.18-1John.2.27">1 John ii, 18-27</scripRef> is peculiarly adapted to little children.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p27">28. And now, beloved children - Having finished his address
to each, he now returns to all in general. Abide in him, that we - A
modest expression. May not be ashamed before him at his coming - O how
will ye, Jews, Socinians, nominal Christians, be ashamed in that
day!</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iii-p28">29. Everyone - And none else. Who practiceth righteousness
- From a believing, loving heart. Is born of him - For all his children
are like himself.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="25.30%" prev="i.xxiv.iii" next="i.xxiv.v" id="i.xxiv.iv">
<h3 id="i.xxiv.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 John III" id="i.xxiv.iv-p0.2" parsed="|1John|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.3" /> 

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p1">1. That we should be called - That is, should be, the
children of God. Therefore the world knoweth us not - They know not what
to make of us. We are a mystery to them.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p2">2. It doth not yet appear - Even to ourselves. What we
shall be - It is something ineffable, which will raise the children of
God to be, in a manner, as God himself. But we know, in general, that
when he, the Son of God, shall appear, we shall be like him - The glory
of God penetrating our inmost substance. For we shall see him as he is -
Manifestly, without a veil. And that sight will transform us into the
same likeness.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p3">3. And every one that hath this hope in him - In God.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p4">4. Whosoever committeth sin - Thereby transgresseth the
holy, just, and good law of God, and so sets his authority at nought;
for this is implied in the very nature of sin.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p5">5. And ye know that he - Christ. Was manifested - That he
came into the world for this very purpose. To take away our sins - To
destroy them all, root and branch, and leave none remaining. And in him
is no sin - So that he could not suffer on his own account, but to make
us as himself.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p6">6. Whosoever abideth in communion with him, by loving
faith, sinneth not - While he so abideth. Whosoever sinneth certainly
seeth him not - The loving eye of his soul is not then fixed upon God;
neither doth he then experimentally know him - Whatever he did in time
past.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p7">7. Let no one deceive you - Let none persuade you that any
man is righteous but he that uniformly practices righteousness; he alone
is righteous, after the example of his Lord.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p8">8. He that committeth sin is a child of the devil; for the
devil sinneth from the beginning - That is, was the first sinner in the
universe, and has continued to sin ever since. The Son of God was
manifested to destroy the works of the devil - All sin. And will he not
perform this in all that trust in him?</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p9">9. Whosoever is born of God - By living faith, whereby God
is continually breathing spiritual life into his soul, and his soul is
continually breathing out love and prayer to God, doth not commit sin.
For the divine seed of loving faith abideth in him; and, so long as it
doth, he cannot sin, because he is born of God - Is inwardly and
universally changed.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p10">10. Neither he that loveth not his brother - Here is the
transition from the general proposition to one particular.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p11">12. Who was of the wicked one - Who showed he was a child
of the devil by killing his brother. And wherefore slew he him - For any
fault? No, but just the reverse; for his goodness.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p12">13. Marvel not if the world hate you - For the same
cause.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p13">14. We know - As if he had said, We ourselves could not
love our brethren, unless we were passed from spiritual death to life,
that is, born of God. He that loveth not his brother abideth in death -
That is, is not born of God. And he that is not born of God, cannot love
his brother.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p14">15. He, I say, abideth in spiritual death, is void of the
life of God. For whosoever hateth his brother, and there is no medium
between loving and hating him, is, in God's account, a murderer: every
degree of hatred being a degree of the same temper which moved Cain to
murder his brother. And no murderer hath eternal life abiding in him -
But every loving believer hath. For love is the beginning of eternal
life. It is the same, in substance, with glory.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p15">16. The word God is not in the original. It was omitted by
the apostle just as the particular name is omitted by Mary, when she
says to the gardener, "Sir, if thou hast born him hence;" and by the
church, when she says, "Let him kiss me with the kisses of his mouth,"
So i, 2; in both which places there is a language, a very emphatical
language, even in silence. It declares how totally the thoughts were
possessed by the blessed and glorious subject. It expresses also the
superlative dignity and amiableness of the person meant, as though He,
and He alone, was, or deserved to be, both known and admired by all.
Because he laid down his life - Not merely for sinners, but for us in
particular. From this truth believed, from this blessing enjoyed, the
love of our brethren takes its rise, which may very justly be admitted
as an evidence that our faith is no delusion.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p16">17. But whoso hath this world's good - Worldly substance,
far less valuable than life. And seeth his brother have need - The very
sight of want knocks at the door of the spectator's heart. And shutteth
up - Whether asked or not. His bowels of compassion from him, how
dwelleth the love of God in him - Certainly not at all, however he may
talk, <scripRef passage="1 John iii. 18" id="i.xxiv.iv-p16.1" parsed="|1John|3|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.3.18">1 John iii, 18</scripRef>, of loving God.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p17">18. Not in word - Only. But in deed - In action: not in
tongue by empty professions, but in truth.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p18">19. And hereby we know - We have a further proof by this
real, operative love. That we are of the truth - That we have true
faith, that we are true children of God. And shall assure our hearts
before him - Shall enjoy the assurance of his favour, and the "testimony
of a good conscience toward God." The heart, in St. John's language, is
the conscience. The word conscience is not found in his writings.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p19">20. For if we have not this testimony, if in anything our
heart, our own conscience, condemn us, much more does God, who is
greater than our heart - An infinitely holier and a more impartial
Judge. And knoweth all things - So that there is no hope of hiding it
from him.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p20">21. If our heart condemn us not - If our conscience, duly
enlightened by the word and Spirit of God, and comparing all our
thoughts, words, and works with that word, pronounce that they agree
therewith. Then have we confidence toward God - Not only our
consciousness of his favour continues and increases, but we have a full
persuasion, that whatsoever we ask we shall receive of him.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p21">23. And this is his commandment - All his commandments in
one word. That we should believe and love - in the manner and degree
which he hath taught. This is the greatest and most important command
that ever issued from the throne of glory. If this be neglected, no
other can be kept: if this be observed, all others are easy.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.iv-p22">24. And he that keepeth his commandments - That thus
believes and loves. Abideth in him, and God in him: and hereby we know
that he abideth in us, by the Spirit which he hath given us - Which
witnesses with our spirits that we are his children, and brings forth
his fruits of peace, love, holiness. This is the transition to the
treating of the Holy Spirit which immediately follows.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="25.42%" prev="i.xxiv.iv" next="i.xxiv.vi" id="i.xxiv.v">
<h3 id="i.xxiv.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 John IV" id="i.xxiv.v-p0.2" parsed="|1John|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.4" /> 

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p1">1. Believe not every spirit - Whereby any teacher is
actuated. But try the spirits - By the rule which follows. We are to try
all spirits by the written word: "To the law and to the testimony!" If
any man speak not according to these, the spirit which actuates him is
not of God.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p2">2. Every spirit - Or teacher. Which confesseth - Both with
heart and voice. Jesus Christ, who is come in the flesh, is of God -
This his coming presupposes, contains, and draws after it, the whole
doctrine of Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p3">3. Ye have heard - From our Lord and us, that it
cometh.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p4">4. Ye have overcome these seducers, because greater is the
Spirit of Christ that is in you than the spirit of antichrist that is in
the world.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p5">5. They - Those false prophets. Are of the world - Of the
number of those that know not God. Therefore speak they of the world -
From the same principle, wisdom, spirit; and, of consequence, the world
heareth them - With approbation.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p6">6. We - Apostles. Are of God - Immediately taught, and sent
by him. Hereby we know - From what is said, <scripRef passage="1 John iv. 2-6" id="i.xxiv.v-p6.1" parsed="|1John|4|2|4|6" osisRef="Bible:1John.4.2-1John.4.6">1 John iv, 2-6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p7">7. Let us love one another - From the doctrine he has just
been defending he draws this exhortation. It is by the Spirit that the
love of God is shed abroad in our hearts. Everyone that truly loveth
God and his neighbour is born of God.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p8">8. God is love - This little sentence brought St. John more
sweetness, even in the time he was writing it, than the whole world can
bring. God is often styled holy, righteous, wise; but not holiness,
righteousness, or wisdom in the abstract, as he is said to be love;
intimating that this is his darling, his reigning attribute, the
attribute that sheds an amiable glory on all his other perfections.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p9">12. If we love one another, God abideth in us - This is
treated of, <scripRef passage="1 John iv. 13-16" id="i.xxiv.v-p9.1" parsed="|1John|4|13|4|16" osisRef="Bible:1John.4.13-1John.4.16">1 John iv,
13-16</scripRef>. And his love is perfected - Has its full effect. In us -
This is treated of, <scripRef passage="1 John iv. 17-19" id="i.xxiv.v-p9.2" parsed="|1John|4|17|4|19" osisRef="Bible:1John.4.17-1John.4.19">1 John iv,
17-19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p10">14. And in consequence of this we have seen and testify
that the Father sent the Son - These are the foundation and the criteria
of our abiding in God and God in us, the communion of the Spirit, and
the confession of the Son.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p11">15. Whosoever shall, from a principle of loving faith,
openly confess in the face of all opposition and danger, that Jesus is
the Son of God, God abideth in him.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p12">16. And we know and believe - By the same Spirit, the love
that God hath to us.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p13">17. Hereby - That is, by this communion with God. Is our
love made perfect; that we may - That is, so that we shall have boldness
in the day of judgment - When all the stout-hearted shall tremble.
Because as he - Christ. Is - All love. So are we - Who are fathers in
Christ, even in this world.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p14">18. There is no fear in love - No slavish fear can be where
love reigns. But perfect, adult love casteth out slavish fear: because
such fear hath torment - And so is inconsistent with the happiness of
love. A natural man has neither fear nor love; one that is awakened,
fear without love; a babe in Christ, love and fear; a father in Christ,
love without fear.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p15">19. We love him, because he first loved us - This is the
sum of all religion, the genuine model of Christianity. None can say
more: why should any one say less, or less intelligibly?</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p16">20. Whom he hath seen - Who is daily presented to his
senses, to raise his esteem, and move his kindness or compassion toward
him.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.v-p17">21. And this commandment have we from him - Both God and

his opinions or mode of worship be, purely because he is the child, and
bears the image, of God. Bigotry is properly the want of this pure and
universal love. A bigot only loves those who embrace his opinions, and
receives his way of worship; and he loves them for that, and not for
Christ's sake.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="25.48%" prev="i.xxiv.v" next="i.xxv" id="i.xxiv.vi">
<h3 id="i.xxiv.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 John V" id="i.xxiv.vi-p0.2" parsed="|1John|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.5" /> 

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p1">1. The scope and sum of this whole paragraph appears from
the conclusion of it, 1 John v, xiii, "These things have I written to
you who believe, that ye may know that ye who believe have eternal
life." So faith is the first and last point with St. John also. Every
one who loveth - God that begat loveth him also that is begotten of him
- Hath a natural affection to all his brethren.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p2">2. Hereby we know - This is a plain proof. That we love the
children of God - As his children.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p3">3. For this is the love of God - The only sure proof of it.
That we keep his commandments: and his commandments are not grievous -
To any that are born of God.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p4">4. For whatsoever - This expression implies the most
unlimited universality. Is born of God overcometh the world - Conquers
whatever it can lay in the way, either to allure or fright the children
of God from keeping his commandments. And this is the victory - The
grand means of overcoming. Even our faith - Seeing all things are
possible to him that believeth.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p5">5. Who is he that overcometh the world - That is superior
to all worldly care, desire, fear? Every believer, and none else. The
seventh verse (usually so reckoned) is a brief recapitulation of all
which has been before advanced concerning the Father, the Son, and the
Spirit. It is cited, in conjunction with the sixth and eighth, <scripRef passage="1 John v. 6, 8" id="i.xxiv.vi-p5.1" parsed="|1John|5|6|0|0;|1John|5|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.5.6 Bible:1John.5.8">1 John v, 6, 8</scripRef> by Tertullian, Cyprian, and an uninterrupted train of
Fathers. And, indeed, what the sun is in the world, what the heart is in
a man, what the needle is in the mariner's compass, this verse is in the
epistle. By this the sixth, eighth, and ninth verses <scripRef passage="1 John v. 6, 8, 9" id="i.xxiv.vi-p5.2" parsed="|1John|5|6|0|0;|1John|5|8|0|0;|1John|5|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.5.6 Bible:1John.5.8 Bible:1John.5.9">1 John v, 6, 8, 9</scripRef> are indissolubly connected; as will be evident, beyond all
contradiction, when they are accurately considered.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p6">6. This is he - St. John here shows the immovable
foundation of that faith that Jesus is the Son of God; not only the
testimony of man, but the firm, indubitable testimony of God. Who came -
Jesus is he of whom it was promised that he should come; and who
accordingly, is come. And this the Spirit, and the water, and the blood
testify. Even Jesus - Who, coming by water and blood, is by this very
thing demonstrated to be the Christ. Not by the water only - Wherein he
was baptized. But by the water and the blood - Which he shed when he had
finished the work his Father had given him to do. He not only undertook
at his baptism "to fulfil all righteousness," but on the cross
accomplished what he had undertaken; in token whereof, when all was
finished, blood and water came out of his side. And it is the Spirit who
likewise testifieth - Of Jesus Christ, namely, by Moses and all the
prophets, by John the Baptist, by all the apostles, and in all the
writings of the New Testament. And against his testimony there can be no
exception, because the Spirit is truth - The very God of truth.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p7">7. What Bengelius has advanced, both concerning the
transposition of these two verses, and the authority of the controverted
verse, partly in his "Gnomon," and partly in his "Apparatus Criticus,"
will abundantly satisfy any impartial person. For there are three that
testify - Literally, testifying, or bearing witness. The participle is
put for the noun witnesses, to intimate that the act of testifying, and
the effect of it, are continually present. Properly, persons only can
testify; and that three are described testifying on earth, as if they
were persons, is elegantly subservient to the three persons testifying
in heaven. The Spirit - In the word, confirmed by miracles. The water -
Of baptism, wherein we are dedicated to the Son, (with the Father and
Spirit,) typifying his spotless purity, and the inward purifying of our
nature. And the blood - Represented in the Lord's supper, and applied to
the consciences of believer. And these three harmoniously agree in one -
In bearing the same testimony, - that Jesus Christ is the divine, the
complete, the only saviour of the world.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p8">8. And there are three that testify in heaven - The
testimony of the Spirit, the water, and the blood, is by an eminent
gradation corroborated by three, who give a still greater testimony. The
Father - Who clearly testified of the Son, both at his baptism and at
his transfiguration. The Word - Who testified of himself on many
occasions, while he was on earth; and again, with still greater
solemnity, after his ascension into heaven, <scripRef passage="Rev. i. 5" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.1" parsed="|Rev|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.1.5">Rev. i, 5</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Rev. xix. 13" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.2" parsed="|Rev|19|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.19.13">Rev. xix, 13</scripRef>. And the Spirit - Whose testimony was added chiefly after
his glorification, chap. ii, 27; <scripRef passage="John xv. 26" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.3" parsed="|John|15|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.15.26">John xv, 26</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Acts v. 32" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.4" parsed="|Acts|5|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.5.32">Acts v, 32</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Rom. viii. 16" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.5" parsed="|Rom|8|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.8.16">Rom. viii, 16</scripRef>. And these three are one - Even as those two, the Father and
the Son, are one, <scripRef passage="John x. 30" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.6" parsed="|John|10|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.10.30">John x, 30</scripRef>. Nothing can separate the Spirit from the Father and the
Son. If he were not one with the Father and the Son, the apostle ought
to have said, The Father and the Word, who are one, and the Spirit, are
two. But this is contrary to the whole tenor of Revelation. It remains
that these three are one. They are one in essence, in knowledge, in
will, and in their testimony. It is observable, the three in the one
verse are opposed, not conjointly, but severally, to the three in the
other: as if he had said, Not only the Spirit testifies, but also the
Father, <scripRef passage="John v. 37" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.7" parsed="|John|5|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.5.37">John v, 37</scripRef>; not only the water, but also the Word, <scripRef passage="John iii. 11" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.8" parsed="|John|3|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.3.11">John iii, 11</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="John x. 41" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.9" parsed="|John|10|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.10.41">John x, 41</scripRef>; not only the blood, but also the Holy Ghost, <scripRef passage="John xv. 26" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.10" parsed="|John|15|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.15.26">John xv,
26</scripRef>, &amp;c. It must now appear, to every reasonable man, how
absolutely necessary the eighth verse is <scripRef passage="1 John v. 8" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.11" parsed="|1John|5|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.5.8">1 John v, 8</scripRef>. St. John could not think of the testimony of the Spirit,
and water, and blood, and subjoin, "The testimony of God is greater,"
without thinking also of the testimony of the Son and Holy Ghost; yea,
and mentioning it in so solemn an enumeration. Nor can any possible
reason be devised, why, without three testifying in heaven, he should
enumerate three, and no more, who testify on earth. The testimony of all
is given on earth, not in heaven; but they who testify are part on
earth, part in heaven. The witnesses who are on earth testify chiefly
concerning his abode on earth, though not excluding his state of
exaltation: the witnesses who are in heaven testify chiefly concerning
his glory at God's right hand, though not excluding his state of
humiliation. The seventh verse, therefore, with the sixth, contains a
recapitulation of the whole economy of Christ, from his baptism to
pentecost; the eighth, the sum of the divine economy, from the time of
his exaltation. Hence it further appears, that this position of the
seventh <scripRef passage="1 John v. 7, 8" id="i.xxiv.vi-p8.12" parsed="|1John|5|7|5|8" osisRef="Bible:1John.5.7-1John.5.8">1 John
v, 7, 8</scripRef> and eighth verses, which places those who testify on earth
before those who testify in heaven, is abundantly preferable to the
other, and affords a gradation admirably suited to the subject.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p9">9. If we receive the testimony of men - As we do
continually, and must do in a thousand instances. The testimony of God
is greater - Of higher authority, and much more worthy to be received;
namely, this very testimony which God the Father, together with the Word
and the Spirit, hath testified of the Son, as the saviour of the
world.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p10">10. He that believeth on the Son of God hath the testimony
- The dear evidence of this, in himself: he that believeth not God, in
this, hath made him a liar; because he supposes that to be false which
God has expressly testified.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p11">11. And this is the sum of that testimony, that God hath
given us a title to, and the real beginning of, eternal life; and that
this is purchased by, and treasured up in, his Son, who has all the
springs and the fulness of it in himself, to communicate to his body,
the church, first in grace and then in glory.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p12">12. It plainly follows, he that hath the Son - Living and
reigning in him by faith. Hath this life; he that hath not the Son of
God hath not this life - Hath no part or lot therein. In the former
clause, the apostle says simply, the Son; because believers know him: in
the latter, the Son of God; that unbelievers may know how great a
blessing they fall short of.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p13">13. These things have I written - In the introduction,
chap. i, 4, he said, I write: now, in the close, I have written. That ye
may know - With a fuller and stronger assurance, that ye have eternal
life.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p14">14. And we - Who believe. Have this further confidence in
him, that he heareth - That is, favourably regards, whatever prayer we
offer in faith, according to his revealed will.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p15">15. We have - Faith anticipates the blessings. The
petitions which we asked of him - Even before the event. And when the
event comes, we know it comes in answer to our prayer.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p16">16. This extends to things of the greatest importance. If
any one see his brother - That is. any man. Sin a sin which is not unto
death - That is, any sin but total apostasy from both the power and form
of godliness. Let him ask, and God will give him life - Pardon and
spiritual life, for that sinner. There is a sin unto death: I do not say
that he shall pray for that - That is, let him not pray for it. A sin
unto death may likewise mean, one which God has determined to punish
with death.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p17">17. All deviation from perfect holiness is sin; but all sin
is not unpardonable.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p18">18. Yet this gives us no encouragement to sin: on the
contrary, it is an indisputable truth, he that is born of God - That
sees and loves God. Sinneth not - So long as that loving faith abides in
him, he neither speaks nor does anything which God hath forbidden. He
keepeth himself - Watching unto prayer. And, while he does this, the
wicked one toucheth him not - So as to hurt him.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p19">19. We know that we are children of God - By the witness
and the fruit of his Spirit, chap. iii, 24. But the whole world - All
who have not his Spirit, not only is "touched" by him, but by idolatry,
fraud, violence lasciviousness, impiety, all manner of wickedness. Lieth
in the wicked one - Void of life, void of sense. In this short
expression the horrible state of the world is painted in the most lively
colours; a comment on which we have in the actions, conversations,
contracts, quarrels, and friendships of worldly men.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p20">20. And we know - By all these infallible proofs. That the
Son of God is come - Into the world. And he hath given us a spiritual
understanding, that we may know him, the true one -"The faithful and
true witness." And we are in the true one - As branches in the vine,
even in Jesus Christ, the eternal Son of God. This Jesus is the only
living and true God, together with the father and the Spirit, and the
original fountain of eternal life. So the beginning and the end of the
epistle agree.</p>

<p id="i.xxiv.vi-p21">21. Keep yourselves from idols - From all worship of false
gods, from all worship of images or of any creature, and from every
inward idol; from loving, desiring, fearing anything more than God. Seek
all help and defense from evil, all happiness in the true God alone.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE SECOND EPISTLE OF ST. JOHN" progress="25.67%" prev="i.xxiv.vi" next="i.xxv.i" id="i.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2John" id="i.xxv-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xxv-p0.2">NOTES ON THE SECOND EPISTLE OF ST. JOHN</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Second John" progress="25.67%" prev="i.xxv" next="i.xxv.ii" id="i.xxv.i">

<p id="i.xxv.i-p1">THE parts of this epistle, written to some Christian
matron, and her religious children, are three:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxv.i-p2">I. The inscription, v. 1-3</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxv.i-p3">II. An exhortation to persevere in true faith
and love,. 4-11</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxv.i-p4">III. The conclusion, 12,13</p>
<h2 id="i.xxv.i-p4.1">2nd JOHN</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="25.68%" prev="i.xxv.i" next="i.xxvi" id="i.xxv.ii">
<h3 id="i.xxv.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 John i" id="i.xxv.ii-p0.2" parsed="|2John|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2John.1.1" /> 

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p1">1. The elder - An appellation suited to a familiar letter,
but upon a weighty subject. To the elect - That is, Christian. Kuria is
undoubtedly a proper name, both here and in ver. 5; for it was not then
usual to apply the title of lady to any but the Roman empress; neither
would such a manner of speaking have been suitable to the simplicity and
dignity of the apostle. Whom - Both her and her children. I love in the
truth - With unfeigned and holy love.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p2">2. For the truth's sake, which abideth in us - As a living
principle of faith and holiness.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p3">3. Grace takes away guilt; mercy, misery: peace implies the
abiding in grace and mercy. It includes the testimony of God's Spirit,
both that we are his children, and that all our ways are acceptable to
him. This is the very foretaste of heaven itself, where it is perfected.
In truth and love - Or, faith and love, as St. Paul speaks. Faith and
truth are here synonymous terms.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p4">4. I found of thy children - Probably in their aunt's
house, ver. 13. Walking in the truth - In faith and love.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p5">5. That which we had from the beginning - Of our Lord's
ministry. Indeed it was, in some sense, from the beginning of the world.
That we may love one another - More abundantly.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p6">6. And this is the proof of true love, universal obedience
built on the love of God. This - Love. Is the great commandment which ye
have heard from the beginning - Of our preaching.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p7">7. Carefully keep what ye have heard from the beginning,
for many seducers are entered into the world, who confess not Jesus
Christ that came in the flesh - Who disbelieve either his prophetic, or
priestly, or kingly office. Whosoever does this is the seducer - From
God. And the antichrist - Fighting against Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p8">8. That we lose not the things which we have wrought -
Which every apostate does. But receive a full reward - Having fully
employed all our talents to the glory of him that gave them. Here again
the apostle modestly transfers it to himself.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p9">9. Receive this as a certain rule: Whosoever transgresseth
- Any law of God. Hath not God - For his Father and his God. He that
abideth in the doctrine of Christ - Believing and obeying it. He hath
both the Father and the Son - For his God.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p10">10. If any came to you - Either as a teacher or a brother.
And bring not this doctrine - That is, advance anything contrary to it.
Receive him not into your house - As either a teacher or a brother-
Neither bid him God speed - Give him no encouragement therein.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p11">11. For he that biddeth him God speed - That gives him any
encouragement, is accessory to his evil deeds.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p12">12. Having many things to write, I was not minded to write
now - Only of these, which were then peculiarly needful.</p>

<p id="i.xxv.ii-p13">13. The children of thy elect or Christian sister - Absent,
if not dead, when the apostle wrote this.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE THIRD EPISTLE OF ST. JOHN" progress="25.73%" prev="i.xxv.ii" next="i.xxvi.i" id="i.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="3John" id="i.xxvi-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xxvi-p0.2">NOTES ON THE THIRD EPISTLE OF ST. JOHN</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Third John" progress="25.73%" prev="i.xxvi" next="i.xxvi.ii" id="i.xxvi.i">

<p id="i.xxvi.i-p1">THE third epistle has likewise three parts:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxvi.i-p2">I. The inscription, 1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxvi.i-p3">II. The commendation of Caius, 3-8 With a
caution against Diotrephes 9-11 And a recommendation of Demetrius,
12</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxvi.i-p4">III. The conclusion, 13-15</p>
<h2 id="i.xxvi.i-p4.1">3rd JOHN</h2> 
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="25.73%" prev="i.xxvi.i" next="i.xxvii" id="i.xxvi.ii">
<h3 id="i.xxvi.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="3 John i" id="i.xxvi.ii-p0.2" parsed="|3John|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:3John.1.1" /> 

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p1">1. Caius was probably that Caius of Corinth whom St. Paul
mentions, <scripRef passage="Rom. xvi. 23" id="i.xxvi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Rom|16|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.16.23">Rom. xvi, 23</scripRef>. If so, either he was removed from Achaia into Asia, or St.
John sent this letter to Corinth.</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p2">3. For - I know thou usest all thy talents to his glory.
The truth that is in thee - The true faith and love.</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p3">4. I have no greater joy than this - Such is the spirit of
every true Christian pastor. To hear that my children walk in the truth
- Caius probably was converted by St. Paul. Therefore when St. John
speaks of him. with other believers, as his children, it may be
considered as the tender style of paternal love, whoever were the
instruments of their conversion. And his using this appellation, when
writing under the character of the elder, has its peculiar beauty.</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p4">5. Faithfully - Uprightly and sincerely.</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p5">6. Who have testified of thy love before the church - The
congregation with whom I now reside. Whom if thou send forward on their
journey - Supplied with what is needful. Thou shalt do well - How
tenderly does the apostle enjoin this!</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p6">7. They went forth - To preach the gospel.</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p7">8. To receive - With all kindness. The truth - Which they
preach.</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p8">9. I wrote to the church - Probably that to which they
came. But Diotrephes - Perhaps the pastor of it. Who loveth to have the
preeminence among them - To govern all things according to his own will.
Receiveth us not - Neither them nor me. So did the mystery of iniquity
already work!</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p9">10. He prateth against us - Both them and me, thereby
endeavouring to excuse himself.</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p10">11. Follow not that which is evil - In Diotrephes. But that
which is good - In Demetrius. He hath not seen God - Is a stranger to
him.</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p11">12. And from the truth itself - That is, what they testify
is the very truth. Yea, we also bear testimony - I and they that are
with me.</p>

<p id="i.xxvi.ii-p12">14. Salute the friends by name - That is, in the same
manner as if I had named them one by one. The word friend does not often
occur in the New Testament, being swallowed up in the more endearing one
of brother.</p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE GENERAL EPISTLE OF ST. JUDE" progress="25.77%" prev="i.xxvi.ii" next="i.xxvii.i" id="i.xxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Jude" id="i.xxvii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xxvii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE GENERAL EPISTLE OF ST. JUDE</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Jude" progress="25.77%" prev="i.xxvii" next="i.xxvii.ii" id="i.xxvii.i">

<p id="i.xxvii.i-p1">THIS epistle has three parts:</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxvii.i-p2">I. The inscription, 1, 2</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxvii.i-p3">II. The treatise, in which,</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxvii.i-p4">1. He exhorts them to contend for the faith,
3</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxvii.i-p5">2. Describes the punishment and the manners
of its adversaries, 4- 16</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxvii.i-p6">3. Warns the believers, 17-19</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxvii.i-p7">4. Confirms them, 20, 21</p>

<p class="List2" id="i.xxvii.i-p8">5. Instructs them in their duty to others,
22, 23</p>

<p class="List1" id="i.xxvii.i-p9">III. The conclusion, 24,</p>
<h2 id="i.xxvii.i-p9.1">JUDE</h2> 

<p id="i.xxvii.i-p10">This epistle greatly resembles the second of St. Peter,
which St. Jude seems to have had in view while he wrote. That was
written but a very little before his death; and hence we may gather that
St. Jude lived some time after it, and saw that grievous declension in
the church which St. Peter had foretold. But he passes over some things
mentioned by St. Peter, repeats some in different expressions and with a
different view, and adds others; clearly evidencing thereby the wisdom
of God which rested upon him. Thus St. Peter cites and confirms St.
Paul's writings, and is himself cited and confirmed by St. Jude.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="25.78%" prev="i.xxvii.i" next="i.xxviii" id="i.xxvii.ii">
<h3 id="i.xxvii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Jude i" id="i.xxvii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Jude|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.1.1" /> 

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p1">1. Jude, a servant of Jesus Christ - The highest glory
which any, either angel or man, can aspire to. The word servant, under
the old covenant, was adapted to the spirit of fear and bondage that
clave to that dispensation. But when the time appointed of the Father
was come, for the sending of his Son to redeem them that were under the
law, the word servant (used by the apostles concerning themselves and
all the children of God) signified one that, having the Spirit of
adoption, is made free by the Son of God. His being a servant is the
fruit and perfection of his being a son. And whenever the throne of God
and of the Lamb shall be in the new Jerusalem, then will it be indeed
that "his servants shall serve him," <scripRef passage="Rev. xxii. 3" id="i.xxvii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Rev|22|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.22.3">Rev. xxii, 3</scripRef>. The brother of James - St. James was the more eminent,
usually styled, "the brother of the Lord." To them that are beloved -
The conclusion, ver. 21, exactly answers the introduction. And preserved
through Jesus Christ - So both the spring and the accomplishment of
salvation are pointed out. This is premised, lest any of them should be
discouraged by the terrible things which are afterwards mentioned. And
called - To receive the whole blessing of God, in time and eternity.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p2">3. When I gave all diligence to write to you of the common
salvation - Designed for all, and enjoyed by all believers. Here the
design of the epistle is expressed; the end of which exactly answers the
beginning. It was needful to exhort you to contend earnestly - Yet
humbly, meekly, and lovingly; otherwise your contention will only hurt
your cause, if not destroy your soul. For the faith - All the
fundamental truths. Once delivered - By God, to remain unvaried for
ever.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p3">4. There are certain men crept in, who were of old
described before - Even as early as Enoch; of whom it was foretold, that
by their wilful sins they would incur this condemnation. Turning the
grace of God - Revealed in the gospel. Into lasciviousness - Into an
occasion of more abandoned wickedness.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p4">5. He afterwards destroyed - The far greater part of that
very people whom he had once saved. Let none therefore presume upon past
mercies, as if he was now out of danger.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p5">6. And the angels, who kept not their first dignity - Once
assigned them under the Son of God. But voluntarily left their own
habitation - Then properly their own, by the free gift of God. He
reserved - Delivered to be kept. In everlasting chains under darkness -
O how unlike their own habitation! When these fallen angels came out of
the hands of God, they were holy; else God made that which was evil: and
being holy, they were beloved of God; else he hated the image of his own
spotless purity. But now he loves them no more; they are doomed to
endless destruction. (for if he loved them still, he would love what is
sinful:) and both his former love, and his present righteous and eternal
displeasure towards the same work of his own hands, are because he
changeth not; because he invariably loveth righteousness, and hateth
iniquity. <scripRef passage="2 Pet. ii. 4" id="i.xxvii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|2Pet|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.2.4">2 Pet. ii, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p6">7. The cities which gave themselves over to fornication -
The word here means, unnatural lusts. Are set forth as an example,
suffering the vengeance of eternal fire - That is, the vengeance which
they suffered is an example or a type of eternal fire.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p7">8. In like manner these dreamers - Sleeping and dreaming
all their lives. Despise authority - Those that are invested with it by
Christ, and made by him the overseers of his flock. Rail at dignities -
The apostle does not seem to speak of worldly dignities. These they had
"in admiration for the sake of gain," ver. 16; but those holy men, who
for the purity of their lives, the soundness of their doctrine, and the
greatness of their labours in the work of the ministry, were truly
honourable before God and all good men; and who were grossly vilified by
those who turned the grace of God into lasciviousness. Probably they
were the impure followers of Simon Magus, the same with the Gnostics and
Nicolaitans, <scripRef passage="Rev. ii. 15" id="i.xxvii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Rev|2|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.2.15">Rev. ii, 15</scripRef>. <scripRef passage="2 Pet. ii. 10" id="i.xxvii.ii-p7.2" parsed="|2Pet|2|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.2.10">2 Pet.
ii, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p8">9. Yet Michael - It does not appear whether St. Jude
learned this by any Revelation or from ancient tradition. It suffices,
that these things were not only true, but acknowledged as such by them
to whom he wrote. The archangel - This word occurs but once more in the
sacred writings, <scripRef passage="1 Thess. iv. 16" id="i.xxvii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|1Thess|4|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.4.16">1 Thess. iv,
16</scripRef>. So that whether there be one archangel only, or more, it is
not possible for us to determine. When he disputed with the devil - At
what time we know not. Concerning the body of Moses - Possibly the devil
would have discovered the place where it was buried, which God for wise
reasons had concealed. Durst not bring even against him a railing
accusation - Though so far beneath him in every respect. But simply
said, (so great was his modesty!) The Lord rebuke thee - I leave thee to
the Judge of all.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p9">10. But these - Without all shame. Rail at the things of
God which they know not - Neither can know, having no spiritual senses.
And the natural things, which they know - By their natural senses, they
abuse into occasions of sin.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p10">11. Woe unto them - Of all the apostles St. Jude alone, and
that in this single place, denounces a woe. St. Peter, to the same
effect, pronounces them "cursed children." For they have gone in the way
of Cain - The murderer. And ran greedily - Literally, have been poured
out, like a torrent without banks. After the error of Balaam - The
covetous false prophet. And perished in the gainsaying of Korah -
Vengeance has overtaken them as it did Korah, rising up against those
whom God had sent.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p11">12. These are spots - Blemishes. In your feasts of love -
Anciently observed in all the churches. Feeding themselves without fear
- Without any fear of God, or jealousy over themselves. Twice dead - In
sin, first by nature, and afterwards by apostasy. Plucked up by the
roots - And so incapable of ever reviving.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p12">13. Wandering stars - Literally, planets, which shine for a
time, but have no light in themselves, and will be soon cast into utter
darkness. Thus the apostle illustrates their desperate wickedness by
comparisons drawn from the air, earth, sea, and heavens.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p13">14. And of these also - As well as the antediluvian sinners
Enoch - So early was the prophecy referred to, ver. 4. The seventh from
Adam - There were only five of the fathers between Adam and Enoch, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. i. 1-3" id="i.xxvii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|1Chr|1|1|1|3" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.1.1-1Chr.1.3">1 Chron. i, 1-3</scripRef>. The first coming of Christ was revealed to Adam; his
second, glorious coming, to Enoch; and the seventh from Adam foretold
the things which will conclude the seventh age of the world. St. Jude
might know this either from some ancient book, or tradition, or
immediate Revelation. Behold - As if it were already done, the Lord
cometh!</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p14">15. To execute judgment - Enoch herein looked beyond the
flood. Upon all - Sinners, in general. And to convict all the ungodly,
in particular, of all the grievous things which ungodly sinners (a
sinner is bad; but the ungodly who sin without fear are worse) have
spoken against him, ver. 8, 10, though they might not think, all those
speeches were against him.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p15">16. These are murmurers - Against men. Complainers -
Literally, complainers of their fate, against God. Walking - With regard
to themselves. After their own foolish and mischievous desires. Having
men's persons in admiration for the sake of gain - Admiring and
commending them only for what they can get.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p16">17. By the apostles - He does not exempt himself from the
number of apostles. For in the next verse he says, they told you, not
us.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p17">19. These are they who separate themselves, sensual, not
having the Spirit - Having natural senses and understanding only, not
the Spirit of God; otherwise they could not separate. For that it is a
sin, and a very heinous one, "to separate from the church," is out of
all question. But then it should be observed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxvii.ii-p18">1. That by the church is meant a body of
living Christians, who are "an habitation of God through the
Spirit:"</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxvii.ii-p19">2. That by separating is understood,
renouncing all religious intercourse with them; no longer joining with
them in solemn prayer, or the other public offices of religion: and,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxvii.ii-p20">3. That we have no more authority from
scripture to call even this schism, than to call it murder.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p21">20. But ye, beloved, not separating, but building
yourselves up in your most holy faith - Than which none can be more holy
in itself, or more conducive to the most refined and exalted holiness.
Praying through the Holy Spirit - Who alone is able to build you up, as
he alone laid the foundation. In this and the following verse St. Jude
mentions the Father, Son, and Spirit, together with faith, love, and
hope.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p22">21. By these means, through his grace, keep yourselves in
the love of God, and in the confident expectation of that eternal life
which is purchased for you, and conferred upon you, through the mere
mercy of our Lord Jesus Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p23">22. Meantime watch over others, as well as yourselves, and
give them such help as their various needs require. For instance,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxvii.ii-p24">1. Some, that are wavering in judgment,
staggered by others or by their own evil reasoning, endeavour more
deeply to convince of the whole truth as it is in Jesus.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxvii.ii-p25">2. Some snatch, with a swift and strong hand,
out of the fire of sin and temptation.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxvii.ii-p26">3. On others show compassion in a milder and
gentler way; though still with a jealous fear, lest yourselves be
infected with the disease you endeavour to cure. See, therefore, that
while you love the sinners, ye retain the utmost abhorrence of their
sins, and of any the least degree of, or approach to, them.</p>

<p id="i.xxvii.ii-p27">24. Now to him who alone is able to keep them from falling
- Into any of these errors or sins. And to present them faultless in the
presence of his glory - That is, in his own presence, when he shall be
revealed in all his glory. Please see Notes at <scripRef passage="Matt. i. 1" id="i.xxvii.ii-p27.1" parsed="|Matt|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.1.1">Matt. i, 1</scripRef></p>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE REVELATION OF JOHN" progress="25.96%" prev="i.xxvii.ii" next="i.xxviii.i" id="i.xxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev" id="i.xxviii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="i.xxviii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE REVELATION OF JOHN</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Revelation" progress="25.96%" prev="i.xxviii" next="i.xxviii.ii" id="i.xxviii.i">

<p id="i.xxviii.i-p1">IT is scarce possible for any that either love or fear God
not to feel their hearts extremely affected in seriously reading either
the beginning or the latter part of the Revelation. These, it is
evident, we cannot consider too much; but the intermediate parts I did
not study at all for many years; as utterly despairing of understanding
them, after the fruitless attempts of so many wise and good men: and
perhaps I should have lived and died in this sentiment, had I not seen
the works of the great Bengelius. But these revived my hopes of
understanding even the prophecies of this book; at least many of them in
some good degree: for perhaps some will not be opened but in eternity.
Let us, however, bless God for the measure of light we may enjoy, and
improve it to his glory. The following notes are mostly those of that
excellent man; a few of which are taken from his Gnornon Novi
Testamenti, but far more from his Ekklarte Offenbarung, which is a full
and regular comment on the Revelation. Every part of this I do not
undertake to defend. But none should condemn him without reading his
proofs at large. It did not suit my design to insert these: they are
above the capacity of ordinary readers. Nor had I room to insert the
entire translation of a book which contains near twelve hundred pages.
All I can do is, partly to translate, partly abridge, the most necessary
of his observations; allowing myself the liberty to alter some of them,
and to add a few notes where he is not full. His text, it may be
observed, I have taken almost throughout, which I apprehend he has
abundantly defended both in the Gnomon itself, and in his Apparatus and
Crisis in Apocalypsin. Yet I by no means pretend to understand or
explain all that is contained in this mysterious book. I only offer what
help I can to the serious inquirer, and shall rejoice if any be moved
thereby more carefully to read and more deeply to consider the words of
this prophecy. Blessed is he that does this with a single eye. His
labour shall not be in vain.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="25.99%" prev="i.xxviii.i" next="i.xxviii.iii" id="i.xxviii.ii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.ii-p0.1">I</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. I" id="i.xxviii.ii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.1" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p1">1. The Revelation - Properly so called; for things covered
before are here revealed, or unveiled. No prophecy in the Old Testament
has this title; it was reserved for this alone in the New. It is, as it
were, a manifesto, wherein the Heir of all things declares that all
power is given him in heaven and earth, and that he will in the end
gloriously exercise that power, maugre all the opposition of all his
enemies. Of Jesus Christ - Not of "John the Divine," a title added in
latter ages. Certain it is, that appellation, the Divine, was not
brought into the church, much less was it affixed to John the apostle,
till long after the apostolic age. It was St. John, indeed, who wrote
this book, but the author of it is Jesus Christ. Which God gave unto him
- According to his holy, glorified humanity, as the great Prophet of the
church. God gave the Revelation to Jesus Christ; Jesus Christ made it
known to his servants. To show - This word recurs, chap. xxii, 6; and in
many places the parts of this book refer to each other. Indeed the whole
structure of it breathes the art of God, comprising, in the most
finished compendium, things to come, many, various; near, intermediate,
remote; the greatest, the least; terrible, comfortable; old, new; long,
short; and these interwoven together, opposite, composite; relative to
each other at a small, at a great, distance; and therefore sometimes, as
it were, disappearing, broken off, suspended, and afterwards
unexpectedly and most seasonably appearing again. In all its parts it
has an admirable variety, with the most exact harmony, beautifully
illustrated by those very digressions which seem to interrupt it. In
this manner does it display the manifold wisdom of God shining in the
economy of the church through so many ages. His servants - Much is
comprehended in this appellation. It is a great thing to be a servant of
Jesus Christ. This book is dedicated particularly to the servants of
Christ in the seven churches in Asia; but not exclusive of all his other
servants, in all nations and ages. It is one single Revelation, and yet
sufficient for them all, from the time it was written to the end of the
world. Serve thou the Lord Jesus Christ in truth: so shalt thou learn
his secret in this book; yea, and thou shalt feel in thy heart whether
this book be divine, or not. The things which must shortly come to pass
- The things contained in this prophecy did begin to be accomplished
shortly after it was given; and the whole might be said to come to pass
shortly, in the same sense as St. Peter says, "The end of all things is
at hand;" and our Lord himself, "Behold, I come quickly." There is in
this book a rich treasure of all the doctrines pertaining to faith and
holiness. But these are also delivered in other parts of holy writ; so
that the Revelation need not to have been given for the sake of these.
The peculiar design of this is, to show the things which must come to
pass. And this we are especially to have before our eyes whenever we
read or hear it. It is said afterward, "Write what thou seest;" and
again, "Write what thou hast seen, and what is, and what shall be
hereafter;" but here, where the scope of the book is shown, it is only
said, the things which must come to pass. Accordingly, the showing
things to come, is the great point in view throughout the whole. And St.
John writes what he has seen, and what is, only as it has an influence
on, or gives light to, what shall be. And he - Jesus Christ. Sent and
signified them - Showed them by signs or emblems; so the Greek word
properly means. By his angel - Peculiarly called, in the sequel, "the
angel of God," and particularly mentioned, chap. xvii, 1; xxi, 9; xxii,
6, 16. To his servant John - A title given to no other single person
throughout the book.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p2">2. Who hath testified - In the following book. The word of
God - Given directly by God. And the testimony of Jesus - Which he hath
left us, as the faithful and true witness. Whatsoever things he saw - In
such a manner as was a full confirmation of the divine original of this
book.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p3">3. Happy is he that readeth, and they that hear, the words
of this prophecy - Some have miserably handled this book. Hence others
are afraid to touch it; and, while they desire to know all things else,
reject only the knowledge of those which God hath shown. They inquire
after anything rather than this; as if it were written, "Happy is he
that doth not read this prophecy." Nay, but happy is he that readeth,
and they that hear, and keep the words thereof - Especially at this
time, when so considerable a part of them is on the point of being
fulfilled. Nor are helps wanting whereby any sincere and diligent
inquirer may understand what he reads therein. The book itself is
written in the most accurate manner possible. It distinguishes the
several things whereof it treats by seven epistles, seven seals, seven
trumpets, seven phials; each of which sevens is divided into four and
three. Many things the book itself explains; as the seven stars; the
seven candlesticks; the lamb, his seven horns and seven eyes; the
incense; the dragon; the heads and horns of the beasts; the fine linen;
the testimony of Jesus: and much light arises from comparing it with the
ancient prophecies, and the predictions in the other books of the New
Testament. In this book our Lord has comprised what was wanting in those
prophecies touching the time which followed his ascension and the end of
the Jewish polity. Accordingly, it reaches from the old Jerusalem to the
new, reducing all things into one sum, in the exactest order, and with a
near resemblance to the ancient prophets. The introduction and
conclusion agree with Daniel; the description of the man child, and the
promises to Zion, with Isaiah; the judgment of Babylon, with Jeremiah;
again, the determination of times, with Daniel; the architecture of the
holy city, with Ezekiel; the emblems of the horses, candlesticks,
&amp;c., with Zechariah. Many things largely described by the prophets
are here summarily repeated; and frequently in the same words. To them
we may then usefully have recourse. Yet the Revelation suffices for the
explaining itself, even if we do not yet understand those prophecies;
yea, it casts much light upon them. Frequently, likewise, where there is
a resemblance between them, there is a difference also; the Revelation,
as it were, taking a stock from one of the old prophets, and inserting a
new graft into it. Thus Zechariah speaks of two olive trees; and so does
St. John; but with a different meaning. Daniel has a beast with ten
horns; so has St. John; but not with quite the same signification. And
here the difference of words, emblems, things, times, ought studiously
to be observed. Our Lord foretold many things before his passion; but
not all things; for it was not yet seasonable. Many things, likewise,
his Spirit foretold in the writings of the apostles, so far as the
necessities of those times required: now he comprises them all in one
short book; therein presupposing all the other prophecies, and at the
same time explaining, continuing, and perfecting them in one thread. It
is right therefore to compare them; but not to measure the fulness of
these by the scantiness of those preceding. Christ, when on earth,
foretold what would come to pass in a short time; adding a brief
description of the last things. Here he foretells the intermediate
things; so that both put together constitute one complete chain of
prophecy. This book is therefore not only the sum and the key of all the
prophecies which preceded, but likewise a supplement to all; the seals
being closed before. Of consequence, it contains many particulars not
revealed in any other part of scripture. They have therefore little
gratitude to God for such a Revelation, reserved for the exaltation of
Christ, who boldly reject whatever they find here which was not
revealed, or not so clearly, in other parts of scripture. He that
readeth and they that hear - St. John probably sent this book by a
single person into Asia, who read it in the churches, while many heard.
But this, likewise, in a secondary sense, refers to all that shall duly
read or hear it in all ages. The words of this prophecy - It is a
Revelation with regard to Christ who gives it; a prophecy, with regard
to John who delivers it to the churches. And keep the things which are
written therein - In such a manner as the nature of them requires;
namely, with repentance, faith, patience, prayer, obedience,
watchfulness, constancy. It behoves every Christian, at all
opportunities, to read what is written in the oracles of God; and to
read this precious book in particular, frequently, reverently, and
attentively. For the time - Of its beginning to be accomplished. Is near
- Even when St. John wrote. How much nearer to us is even the full
accomplishment of this weighty prophecy!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p4">4. John - The dedication of this book is contained in the
fourth, fifth, and sixth verses; but the whole Revelation is a kind of
letter. To the seven churches which are in Asia - That part of the
Lesser Asia which was then a Roman province. There had been several
other churches planted here; but it seems these were now the most
eminent; and it was among these that St. John had laboured most during
his abode in Asia. In these cities there were many Jews. Such of them as
believed in each were joined with the gentile believers in one church.
Grace be unto you, and peace - The favour of God, with all temporal and
eternal blessings. From him who is, and who was, and who cometh, or, who
is to come - A wonderful translation of the great name JEHOVAH: he was
of old, he is now, he cometh; that is, will be forever. And from the
seven spirits which are before his throne - Christ is he who "hath the
seven spirits of God." "The seven lamps which burn before the throne are
the seven spirits of God." " The lamb hath seven horns and seven eyes,
which are the seven spirits of God." Seven was a sacred number in the
Jewish church: but it did not always imply a precise number. It
sometimes is to be taken figuratively, to denote completeness or
perfection. By these seven spirits, not seven created angels, but the
Holy Ghost is to be understood. The angels are never termed spirits in
this book; and when all the angels stand up, while the four living
creatures and the four and twenty elders worship him that sitteth on the
throne, and the Lamb, the seven spirits neither stand up nor worship. To
these "seven spirits of God," the seven churches, to whom the Spirit
speaks so many things, are subordinate; as are also their angels, yea,
and "the seven angels which stand before God." He is called the seven
spirits, not with regard to his essence, which is one, but with regard
to his manifold operations.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p5">5. And from Jesus Christ, the faithful witness, the first
begotten from the dead, and the prince of the kings of the earth - Three
glorious appellations are here given him, and in their proper order. He
was the faithful witness of the whole will of God before his death, and
in death, and remains such in glory. He rose from the dead, as "the
first fruits of them that slept;" and now hath all power both in heaven
and earth. He is here styled a prince: but by and by he hears his title
of king; yea, King of kings, and Lord of lords." This phrase, the kings
of the earth, signifies their power and multitude, and also the nature
of their kingdom. It became the Divine Majesty to call them kings with a
limitation; especially in this manifesto from his heavenly kingdom; for
no creature, much less a sinful man, can bear the title of king in an
absolute sense before the eyes of God.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p6">6. To him that loveth us, and, out of that free, abundant
love, hath washed us from the guilt and power of our sins with his own
blood, and hath made us kings - Partakers of his present, and heirs of
his eternal, kingdom. And priests unto his God and Father - To whom we
continually offer ourselves, an holy, living sacrifice. To him be the
glory - For his love and redemption. And the might - Whereby he governs
all things.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p7">7. Behold - In this and the next verse is the proposition,
and the summary of the whole book. He cometh - Jesus Christ. Throughout
this book, whenever it is said, He cometh, it means his glorious coming.
The preparation for this began at the destruction of Jerusalem, and more
particularly at the time of writing this book; and goes on, without any
interruption, till that grand event is accomplished. Therefore it is
never said in this book, He will come; but, He cometh. And yet it is not
said, He cometh again: for when he came before, it was not like himself,
but in "the form of a servant." But his appearing in glory is properly
his coming; namely, in a manner worthy of the Son of God. And every eye
- Of the Jews in particular. Shall see him - But with what different
emotions, according as they had received or rejected him. And they who
have pierced him - They, above all, who pierced his hands, or feet, or
side. Thomas saw the print of these wounds even after his resurrection;
and the same, undoubtedly, will be seen by all, when he cometh in the
clouds of heaven. And all the tribes of the earth - The word tribes, in
the Revelation, always means the Israelites: but where another word,
such as nations or people, is joined with it, it implies likewise (as
here) all the rest of mankind. Shall wail because of him - For terror
and pain, if they did not wail before by true repentance. Yea, Amen -
This refers to, every eye shall see him. He that cometh saith, Yea; he
that testifies it, Amen. The word translated yea is Greek; Amen is
Hebrew: for what is here spoken respects both Jew and gentile.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p8">8. I am the Alpha and the Omega, saith the Lord God - Alpha
is the first, Omega, the last, letter in the Greek alphabet. Let his
enemies boast and rage ever so much in the intermediate time, yet the
Lord God is both the Alpha, or beginning, and the Omega, or end, of all
things. God is the beginning, as he is the Author and Creator of all
things, and as he proposes, declares, and promises so great things: he
is the end, as he brings all the things which are here revealed to a
complete and glorious conclusion. Again, the beginning and end of a
thing is in scripture styled the whole thing. Therefore God is the Alpha
and the Omega, the beginning and the end; that is, one who is all
things, and always the same.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p9">9. I John - The instruction and preparation of the apostle
for the work are described from the ninth to the twentieth verse. ver.
9- 20, Your brother - In the common faith. And companion in the
affliction - For the same persecution which carried him to Patmos drove
them into Asia. This book peculiarly belongs to those who are under the
cross. It was given to a banished man; and men in affliction understand
and relish it most. Accordingly, it was little esteemed by the Asiatic
church, after the time of Constantine; but highly valued by all the
African churches, as it has been since by all the persecuted children of
God. In the affliction, and kingdom and patience of Jesus - The kingdom
stands in the midst. It is chiefly under various afflictions that faith
obtains its part in the kingdom; and whosoever is a partaker of this
kingdom is not afraid to suffer for Jesus, <scripRef passage="2 Tim. ii. 12" id="i.xxviii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|2Tim|2|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.2.12">2 Tim. ii, 12</scripRef>. I was in the island Patmos - In the reign of Domitian and
of Nerva. And there he saw and wrote all that follows. It was a place
peculiarly proper for these visions. He had over against him, at a small
distance, Asia and the seven churches; going on eastward, Jerusalem and
the land of Canaan; and beyond this, Antioch, yea, the whole continent
of Asia. To the west, he had Romans, Italy, and all Europe, swimming, as
it were, in the sea; to the south, Alexandria and the Nile with its
outlets, Egypt, and all Africa; and to the north, what was afterwards
called Constantinople, on the straits between Europe and Asia. So he had
all the three parts of the world which were then known, with all
Christendom, as it were, before his eyes; a large theatre for all the
various scenes which were to pass before him: as if this island had been
made principally for this end, to serve as an observatory for the
apostle. For preaching the word of God he was banished thither, and for
the testimony of Jesus - For testifying that he is the Christ.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p10">10. I was in the Spirit - That is, in a trance, a prophetic
vision; so overwhelmed with the power, and filled with the light, of the
Holy Spirit, as to be insensible of outward things, and wholly taken up
with spiritual and divine. What follows is one single, connected vision,
which St. John saw in one day; and therefore he that would understand it
should carry his thought straight on through the whole, without
interruption. The other prophetic books are collections of distinct
prophecies, given upon various occasions: but here is one single
treatise, whereof all the parts exactly depend on each other. chap. iv,
1 is connected with ver. 19 and what is delivered in the fourth chapter
goes on directly to the twenty- second. On the Lord's day - On this our
Lord rose from the dead: on this the ancients believed he will come to
judgment. It was, therefore, with the utmost propriety that St. John on
this day both saw and described his coming. And I heard behind me - St.
John had his face to the east: our Lord, likewise, in this appearance
looked eastward toward Asia, whither the apostle was to write. A great
voice, as of a trumpet - Which was peculiarly proper to proclaim the
coming of the great King, and his victory over all his enemies.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p11">11. Saying, What thou seest - And hearest. He both saw and
heard. This command extends to the whole book. All the books of the New
Testament were written by the will of God; but none were so expressly
commanded to be written. In a book - So all the Revelation is but one
book: nor did the letter to the angel of each church belong to him or
his church only; but the whole book was sent to them all. To the
churches - Hereafter named; and through them to all churches, in all
ages and nations. To Ephesus - Mark. Thomas Smith, who in the year 1671
travelled through all these cities, observes, that from Ephesus to
Smyrna is forty-six English miles; from Smyrna to Pergamos, sixty-four;
from Pergamos to Thyatira, forty-eight; from Thyatira to Sardis,
thirty-three; from Sardis to Philadelphia, twenty-seven; from
Philadelphia to Laodicea, about forty-two miles.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p12">12, 13. And I turned to see the voice - That is, to see him
whose voice it was. And being turned, I saw - It seems, the vision
presented itself gradually. First he heard a voice; and, upon looking
behind, he saw the golden candlesticks, and then, in the midst of the
candlesticks, which were placed in a circle, he saw one like a son of
man - That is, in an human form. As a man likewise our Lord doubtless
appears in heaven: though not exactly in this symbolical manner, wherein
he presents himself as the head of his church. He next observed that our
Lord was clothed with a garment down to the foot, and girt with a golden
girdle - Such the Jewish high priests wore. But both of them are here
marks of royal dignity likewise. Girt about at the breast - he that is
on a journey girds his loins. Girding the breast was an emblem of solemn
rest. It seems that the apostle having seen all this, looked up to
behold the face of our Lord: but was beat back by the appearance of his
flaming eyes, which occasioned his more particularly observing his feet.
Receiving strength to raise his eyes again, he saw the stars in his
right hand, and the sword coming out of his mouth: but upon beholding
the brightness of his glorious countenance, which probably was much
increased since the first glance the apostle had of it, he "fell at his
feet as dead." During the time that St. John was discovering these
several particulars, our Lord seems to have been speaking. And doubtless
even his voice, at the very first, bespoke the God: though not so
insupportably as his glorious appearance.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p13">14. His head and his hair - That is, the hair of his head,
not his whole head. Were white as white wool - Like the Ancient of Days,
represented in Daniel's vision, <scripRef passage="Dan. vii. 9" id="i.xxviii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Dan|7|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.7.9">Dan.
vii, 9</scripRef>. Wool is commonly supposed to be an emblem of eternity. As
snow - Betokening his spotless purity. And his eyes as a flame of fire -
Piercing through all things; a token of his omniscience.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p14">15. And his feet like fine brass - Denoting his stability
and strength. As if they burned in a furnace - As if having been melted
and refined, they were still red hot. And his voice - To the comfort of
his friends, and the terror of his enemies. As the voice of many waters
- Roaring aloud, and bearing down all before them.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p15">16. And he had in his right hand seven stars - In token of
his favour and powerful protection. And out of his mouth went a sharp
two-edged sword - Signifying his justice and righteous anger,
continually pointed against his enemies as a sword; sharp, to stab;
two-edged, to hew. And his countenance was as the sun shineth in his
strength - Without any mist or cloud.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p16">17. And I fell at his feet as dead - Human nature not being
able to sustain so glorious an appearance. Thus was he prepared (like
Daniel of old, whom he peculiarly resembles) for receiving so weighty a
prophecy. A great sinking of nature usually precedes a large
communication of heavenly things. St. John, before our Lord suffered,
was so intimate with him, as to lean on his breast, to lie in his bosom.
Yet now, near seventy years after, the aged apostle is by one glance
struck to the ground. What a glory must this be! Ye sinners, be afraid
cleanse your hands: purify your hearts. Ye saints, be humble, prepare:
rejoice. But rejoice unto him with reverence: an increase of reverence
towards this awful majesty can be no prejudice to your faith. Let all
petulancy, with all vain curiosity, be far away, while you are thinking
or reading of these things. And he laid his right hand upon me - The
same wherein he held the seven stars. What did St. John then feel in
himself? Saying, Fear not - His look terrifies, his speech strengthens.
He does not call John by his name, (as the angels did Zechariah and
others,) but speaks as his well known master. What follows is also
spoken to strengthen and encourage him. I am - When in his state of
humiliation he spoke of his glory, he frequently spoke in the third
person, as <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 64" id="i.xxviii.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|26|64|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.64">Matt. xxvi, 64</scripRef>. But he now speaks of his own glory, without any veil, in
plain and direct terms. The first and the last - That is, the one,
eternal God, who is from everlasting to everlasting, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xli. 4" id="i.xxviii.ii-p16.2" parsed="|Isa|41|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.41.4">Isaiah xli, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p17">18. And he that liveth - Another peculiar title of God. And
I have the keys of death and of hades - That is, the invisible world. In
the intermediate state, the body abides in death, the soul in hades.
Christ hath the keys of, that is, the power over, both; killing or
quickening of the body, and disposing of the soul, as it pleaseth him.
He gave St. Peter the keys of the kingdom of heaven; but not the keys of
death or of hades. How come then his supposed successor at Rome by the
keys of purgatory? From the preceding description, mostly, are taken the
titles given to Christ in the following letters, particularly the four
first.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p18">19. Write the things which thou hast seen - This day: which
accordingly are written, ver. 11-18. And which are - The instructions
relating to the present state of the seven churches. These are written,
ver. 20-chap. iii, 22. And which shall be hereafter - To the end of the
world; written, chap. iv, 1, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ii-p19">20. Write first the mystery - The mysterious meaning of the
seven stars - St. John knew better than we do, in how many respects
these stars were a proper emblem of those angels: how nearly they
resembled each other, and how far they differed in magnitude,
brightness, and other circumstances. The seven stars are angels of
the seven churches - Mentioned in the eleventh verse. In each church
there was one pastor or ruling minister, to whom all the rest were
subordinate. This pastor, bishop, or overseer, had the peculiar care
over that flock: on him the prosperity of that congregation in a great
measure depended, and he was to answer for all those souls at the
judgment seat of Christ. And the seven candlesticks are seven churches -
How significant an emblem is this! For a candlestick, though of gold,
has no light of itself; neither has any church, or child of man. But
they receive from Christ the light of truth, holiness, comfort, that it
may shine to all around them. As soon as this was spoken St. John wrote
it down, even all that is contained in this first chapter. Afterwards
what was contained in the second and third chapters was dictated to him
in like manner.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="26.43%" prev="i.xxviii.ii" next="i.xxviii.iv" id="i.xxviii.iii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.iii-p0.1">II</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. II" id="i.xxviii.iii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.2" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p1">Of the following letters to the angels of the seven
churches it may be necessary to speak first in general, and then
particularly. In general we may observe, when the Israelites were to
receive the law at Mount Sinai, they were first to be purified; and when
the kingdom of God was at hand, John the Baptist prepared men for it by
repentance. In like manner we are prepared by these letters for the
worthy reception of this glorious Revelation. By following the
directions given herein, by expelling incorrigibly wicked men, and
putting away all wickedness, those churches were prepared to receive
this precious depositum. And whoever in any age would profitably read or
hear it, must observe the same admonitions. These letters are a kind of
sevenfold preface to the book. Christ now appears in the form of a man,
(not yet under the emblem of a lamb,) and speaks mostly in proper, not
in figurative, words. It is not till chap. iv, 1, that St. John enters
upon that grand vision which takes up the residue of the book. There is
in each of these letters,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p2">1. A command to write to the angel of the
church;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p3">2. A glorious title of Christ;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p4">3. An address to the angel of that church,
containing A testimony of his mixed, or good, or bad state; An
exhortation to repentance or steadfastness; A declaration of what will
be; generally, of the Lord's coming;</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p5">4. A promise to him that overcometh, together
with the exhortation, "He that hath an ear to hear, let him hear" The
address in each letter is expressed in plain words, the promise, in
figurative. In the address our Lord speaks to the angel of each church
which then was, and to the members thereof directly; whereas in the
promise he speaks of all that should overcome, in whatever church or
age, and deals out to them one of the precious promises, (by way of
anticipation,) from the last chapters of the book.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p6">1. Write - So Christ dictated to him every word. These
things saith he who holdeth the seven stars in his right hand - Such is
his mighty power! Such his favour to them and care over them, that they
may indeed shine as stars, both by purity of doctrine and holiness of
life! Who walketh - According to his promise, "I am with you always,
even to the end of the world." In the midst of the golden candlesticks -
Beholding all their works and thoughts, and ready to "remove the
candlestick out of its place," if any, being warned, will not repent.
Perhaps here is likewise an allusion to the office of the priests in
dressing the lamps, which was to keep them always burning before the
Lord.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p7">2. I know - Jesus knows all the good and all the evil,
which his servants and his enemies suffer and do. Weighty word, "I
know," how dreadful will it one day sound to the wicked, how sweet to
the righteous! The churches and their angels must have been astonished,
to find their several states so exactly described, even in the absence
of the apostle, and could not but acknowledge the all-seeing eye of
Christ and of his Spirit. With regard to us, to every one of us also he
saith, "I know thy works." Happy is he that conceives less good of
himself, than Christ knows concerning him. And thy labour - After the
general, three particulars are named, and then more largely described in
an inverted order,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p8">1. Thy labour</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.iii-p9">6. Thou hast born for my name's sake and hast
not fainted.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p10">2. Thy patience:</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.iii-p11">5. Thou hast patience:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p12">3. Thou canst not</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.iii-p13">4. Thou hast tried those who say they are
bear evil men: apostles and are not, and hast found them liars. And thy
patience - Notwithstanding which thou canst not bear that incorrigibly
wicked men should remain in the flock of Christ. And thou hast tried
those who say they are apostles, and are not - For the Lord hath not
sent them.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p14">4. But I have against thee, that thou hast left thy first
love - That love for which all that church was so eminent when St. Paul
wrote his epistle to them. He need not have left this. He might have
retained it entire to the end. And he did retain it in part, or there
could not have remained so much of what was commendable in him. But he
had not kept, as he might have done, the first tender love in its vigour
and warmth. Reader, hast thou?</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p15">5. It is not possible for any to recover the first love,
but by taking these three steps,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p16">1. Remember:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p17">2. Repent:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.iii-p18">3. Do the first works. Remember from whence
thou art fallen - From what degree of faith, love, holiness, though
perhaps insensibly. And repent - Which in the very lowest sense implies
a deep and lively conviction of thy fall. Of the seven angels, two, at
Ephesus and at Pergamos, were in a mixed state; two, at Sardis and at
Laodicea, were greatly corrupted: all these are exhorted to repent; as
are the followers of Jezebel at Thyatira: two, at Smyrna and
Philadelphia, were in a flourishing state, and are therefore only
exhorted to steadfastness. There can be no state, either of any pastor,
church, or single person, which has not here suitable instructions. All,
whether ministers or hearers, together with their secret or open
enemies, in all places and all ages, may draw hence necessary
self-knowledge, reproof, commendation, warning, or confirmation. Whether
any be as dead as the angel at Sardis, or as much alive as the angel at
Philadelphia, this book is sent to him, and the Lord Jesus hath
something to say to him therein. For the seven churches with their
angels represent the whole Christian church, dispersed throughout the
whole world, as it subsists, not, as some have imagined, in one age
after another, but in every age. This is a point of deep importance, and
always necessary to be remembered: that these seven churches are, as it
were, a sample of the whole church of Christ, as it was then, as it is
now, and as it will be in all ages. Do the first works - Outwardly and
inwardly, or thou canst never regain the first love. But if not - By
this word is the warning sharpened to those five churches which are
called to repent; for if Ephesus was threatened, how much more shall
Sardis and Laodicea be afraid! And according as they obey the call or
not, there is a promise or a threatening, ver. 5, 16, 22; chap. iii, 3,
20. But even in the threatening the promise is implied, in case of true
repentance. I come to thee, and will remove thy candlestick out of its
place - I will remove, unless thou repent, the flock now under thy care
to another place, where they shall be better taken care of. But from the
flourishing state of the church of Ephesus after this, there is reason
to believe he did repent.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p19">6. But thou hast this - Divine grace seeks whatever may
help him that is fallen to recover his standing. That thou hatest the
works of the Nicolaitans - Probably so called from Nicolas, one of the
seven deacons, <scripRef passage="Acts vi. 5" id="i.xxviii.iii-p19.1" parsed="|Acts|6|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.6.5">Acts vi, 5</scripRef>. Their doctrines and lives were equally corrupt. They
allowed the most abominable lewdness and adulteries, as well as
sacrificing to idols; all which they placed among things indifferent,
and pleaded for as branches of Christian liberty.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p20">7. He that hath an ear, let him hear - Every man, whoever
can hear at all, ought carefully to hear this. What the Spirit saith -
In these great and precious promises. To the churches - And in them to
every one that overcometh; that goeth on from faith and by faith to full
victory over the world, and the flesh, and the devil. In these seven
letters twelve promises are contained, which are an extract of all the
promises of God. Some of them are not expressly mentioned again in this
book, as "the hidden manna," the inscription of "the name of the new
Jerusalem," the "sitting upon the throne." Some resemble what is
afterwards mentioned, as "the hidden name," chap. xix, 12; "the ruling
the nations," chap. xix, 15; "the morning star," chap. xxii, 16. And
some are expressly mentioned, as "the tree of life," chap. xxii, 2;
freedom from "the second death," chap. xx, 6; the name in "the book of
life," chap. xx, 12; xxi, 27; the remaining "in the temple of God,"
chap. vii, 15; the inscription of "the name of God and of the Lamb,"
chap. xiv, 1; xxii, 4. In these promises sometimes the enjoyment of the
highest goods, sometimes deliverance from the greatest evils, is
mentioned. And each implies the other, so that where either part is
expressed, the whole is to be understood. That part is expressed which
has most resemblance to the virtues or works of him that was spoken to
in the letter preceding. To eat of the tree of life - The first thing
promised in these letters is the last and highest in the accomplishment,
chap. xxii, 2, 14, 19. The tree of life and the water of life go
together, chap. xxii, 1, 2; both implying the living with God eternally.
In the paradise of my God - The word paradise means a garden of
pleasure. In the earthly paradise there was one tree of life: there are
no other trees in the paradise of God.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p21">8. These things saith the first and the last, who was dead
and is alive - How directly does this description tend to confirm him
against the fear of death! verses 10, 11. ver. 10, 11 Even with the
comfort wherewith St. John himself was comforted, chap. i, 17, 18, shall
the angel of this church be comforted.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p22">9. I know thy affliction and poverty - A poor prerogative
in the eyes of the world! The angel at Philadelphia likewise had in
their sight but "a little strength." And yet these two were the most
honourable of all in the eyes of the Lord. But thou art rich - In faith
and love, of more value than all the kingdoms of the earth. Who say they
are Jews - God's own people. And are not - They are not Jews inwardly,
not circumcised in heart. But a synagogue of Satan - Who, like them, was
a liar and a murderer from the beginning.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p23">10. The first and last words of this verse are particularly
directed to the minister; whence we may gather, that his suffering and
the affliction of the church were at the same time, and of the same
continuance. Fear none of those things which thou art about to suffer -
Probably by means of the false Jews. Behold - This intimates the
nearness of the affliction. Perhaps the ten days began on the very day
that the Revelation was read at Smyrna, or at least very soon after. The
devil - Who sets all persecutors to work; and these more particularly.
Is about to cast some of you - Christians at Smyrna; where, in the first
ages, the blood of many martyrs was shed. Into prison, that ye may be
tried - To your unspeakable advantage, chap. iv, 12, 14. And ye shall
have affliction - Either in your own persons, or by sympathizing with
your brethren. Ten days - (Literally taken) in the end of Domitian's
persecution, which was stopped by the edict of the emperor Nerva. Be
thou faithful - Our Lord does not say, "till I come," as in the other
letters, but unto death - Signifying that the angel of this church
should quickly after seal his testimony with his blood; fifty years
before the martyrdom of Polycarp, for whom some have mistaken him. And I
will give thee the crown of life - The peculiar reward of them who are
faithful unto death.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p24">11. The second death - The lake of fire, the portion of the
fearful, who do not overcome, chap. xxi, 8.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p25">12. The sword - With which I will cut off the impenitent,
verse 16.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p26">13. Where the throne of Satan is - Pergamos was above
measure given to idolatry: so Satan had his throne and full residence
there. Thou holdest fast my name - Openly and resolutely confessing me
before men. Even in the days wherein Antipas - Martyred under Domitian.
Was my faithful witness - Happy is he to whom Jesus, the faithful and
true witness, giveth such a testimony!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p27">14. But thou hast there - Whom thou oughtest to have
immediately cast out from the flock. Them that hold the doctrine of
Balaam - Doctrine nearly resembling his. Who taught Balak - And the rest
of the Moabites. To cast a stumblingblock before the sons of Israel -
They are generally termed, the children, but here, the sons, of Israel,
in opposition to the daughters of Moab, by whom Balaam enticed them to
fornication and idolatry. To eat things sacrificed to idols - Which, in
so idolatrous a city as Pergamos, was in the highest degree hurtful to
Christianity. And to commit fornication - Which was constantly joined
with the idol-worship of the heathens.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p28">15. In like manner thou also - As well as the angel at
Ephesus. Hast them that hold the doctrine of the Nicolaitans - And thou
sufferest them to remain in the flock.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p29">16. If not, I come to thee - who wilt not wholly escape
when I punish them. And will fight with them - Not with the Nicolaitans,
who are mentioned only by the by, but the followers of Balaam. With the
sword of my mouth - With my just and fierce displeasure. Balaam himself
was first withstood by the angel of the Lord with "his sword drawn," <scripRef passage="Num. xxii. 23" id="i.xxviii.iii-p29.1" parsed="|Num|22|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.22.23">Num. xxii, 23</scripRef>, and afterwards "slain with the sword," <scripRef passage="Num. xxxi. 8" id="i.xxviii.iii-p29.2" parsed="|Num|31|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.31.8">Num.
xxxi, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p30">17. To him that overcometh - And eateth not of those
sacrifices. Will I give of the hidden manna - Described, <scripRef passage="John vi." id="i.xxviii.iii-p30.1" parsed="|John|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.6">John vi.</scripRef> The
new name answers to this: it is now "hid with Christ in God." The Jewish
manna was kept in the ancient ark of the covenant. The heavenly ark of
the covenant appears under the trumpet of the seventh angel, chap. xi,
19, where also the hidden manna is mentioned again. It seems properly to
mean, the full, glorious, everlasting fruition of God. And I will give
him a white stone - The ancients, on many occasions, gave their votes in
judgment by small stones; by black, they condemned; by white ones they
acquitted. Sometimes also they wrote on small smooth stones. Here may be
an allusion to both. And a new name - So Jacob, after his victory,
gained the new name of Israel. Wouldest thou know what thy new name will
be? The way to this is plain, - overcome. Till then all thy inquiries
are vain. Thou wilt then read it on the white stone.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p31">18. And to the angel of the church at Thyatira - Where the
faithful were but a little flock. These things saith the Son of God -
See how great he is, who appeared "like a son of man!" chap. i, 13. Who
hath eyes as a flame of fire - "Searching the reins and the heart,"
verse 23. And feet like fine brass - Denoting his immense strength. Job
comprises both these, his wisdom to discern whatever is amiss, and his
power to avenge it, in one sentence, <scripRef passage="Job xlii. 2" id="i.xxviii.iii-p31.1" parsed="|Job|42|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.42.2">Job
xlii, 2</scripRef>, "No thought is hidden from him, and he can do all
things."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p32">19. I know thy love - How different a character is this
from that of the angel of the church at Ephesus! The latter could not
bear the wicked, and hated the works of the Nicolaitans; but had left
his first love and first works. The former retained his first love, and
had more and more works, but did bear the wicked, did not withstand them
with becoming vehemence. Mixed characters both; yet the latter, not the
former, is reproved for his fall, and commanded to repent. And faith,
and thy service, and patience - Love is shown, exercised, and improved
by serving God and our neighbour; so is faith by patience and good
works.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p33">20. But thou sufferest that woman Jezebel - who ought not
to teach at all,</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p34"><scripRef passage="1 Tim. ii. 12" id="i.xxviii.iii-p34.1" parsed="|1Tim|2|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.2.12">1 Tim. ii, 12</scripRef>. To teach and seduce my servants - At Pergamos were many
followers of Balaam; at Thyatira, one grand deceiver. Many of the
ancients have delivered, that this was the wife of the pastor himself.
Jezebel of old led the people of God to open idolatry. This Jezebel,
fitly called by her name, from the resemblance between their works, led
them to partake in the idolatry of the heathens. This she seems to have
done by first enticing them to fornication, just as Balaam did: whereas
at Pergamos they were first enticed to idolatry, and afterwards to
fornication.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p35">21. And I gave her time to repent - So great is the power
of Christ! But she will not repent - So, though repentance is the gift
of God, man may refuse it; God will not compel.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p36">22. I will cast her into a bed-into great affliction-and
them that commit either carnal or spiritual adultery with her, unless
they repent - She had her time before. Of her works - Those to which she
had enticed their and which she had committed with them. It is
observable, the angel of the church at Thyatira was only blamed for
suffering her. This fault ceased when God took vengeance on her.
Therefore he is not expressly exhorted to repent, though it is
implied.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p37">23. And I will kill her children - Those which she hath
born in adultery, and them whom she hath seduced. With death - This
expression denotes death by the plague, or by some manifest stroke of
God's hand. Probably the remarkable vengeance taken on her children was
the token of the certainty of all the rest. And all the churches - To
which thou now writest. Shall know that I search the reins - The
desires. And hearts - Thoughts.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p38">24. But I say to you who do not hold this doctrine - Of
Jezebel. Who have not known the depths of Satan - O happy ignorance! As
they speak - That were continually boasting of the deep things which
they taught. Our Lord owns they were deep, even deep as hell: for they
were the very depths of Satan. Were these the same of which Martin
Luther speaks? It is well if there are not some of his countrymen now in
England who know them too well! I will lay upon you no other burden -
Than that you have already suffered from Jezebel and her adherents.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p39">25. What ye - Both the angel and the church have.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p40">26. By works - Those which I have commanded. To him will I
give power over the nations - That is, I will give him to share with me
in that glorious victory which the Father hath promised me over all the
nations who as yet resist me, <scripRef passage="Psalm ii. 8, 9" id="i.xxviii.iii-p40.1" parsed="|Ps|2|8|2|9" osisRef="Bible:Ps.2.8-Ps.2.9">Psalm
ii, 8, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p41">27. And he shall rule them - That is, shall share with me
when I do this. With a rod of iron - With irresistible power, employed
on those only who will not otherwise submit; who will hereby be dashed
in pieces - Totally conquered.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iii-p42">28. I will give him the morning star - Thou, O Jesus, art
the morning star! O give thyself to me! Then will I desire no sun, only
thee, who art the sun also. He whom this star enlightens has always
morning and no evening. The duties and promises here answer each other;
the valiant conqueror has power over the stubborn nations. And he that,
after having conquered his enemies, keeps the works of Christ to the
end, shall have the morning star, - an unspeakable brightness and
peaceable dominion in him.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="26.75%" prev="i.xxviii.iii" next="i.xxviii.v" id="i.xxviii.iv">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.iv-p0.1">III</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. III" id="i.xxviii.iv-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.3" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p1">1. The seven spirits of God - The Holy Spirit, from whom
alone all spiritual life and strength proceed. And the seven stars -
which are subordinate to him. Thou hast a name that thou livest - A fair
reputation, a goodly outside appearance. But that Spirit seeth through
all things, and every empty appearance vanishes before him.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p2">2. The things which remain - In thy soul; knowledge of the
truth, good desires, and convictions. Which were ready to die - Wherever
pride, indolence, or levity revives, all the fruits of the Spirit are
ready to die.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p3">3. Remember how - Humbly, zealously, seriously. Thou didst
receive the grace of God once, and hear - His word. And hold fast - The
grace thou hast received. And repent - According to the word thou hast
heard.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p4">4. Yet thou hast a few names - That is, persons. But though
few, they had not separated themselves from the rest; otherwise, the
angel of Sardis would not have had them. Yet it was no virtue of his,
that they were unspotted; whereas it was his fault that they were but
few. Who have not defiled their garments - Either by spotting
themselves, or by partaking of other men's sins. They shall walk with me
in white - in joy; in perfect holiness; in glory. They are worthy - A
few good among many bad are doubly acceptable to God. O how much happier
is this worthiness than that mentioned, chap. xvi, 6.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p5">5. He shall be clothed in white raiment - The colour of
victory, joy, and triumph. And I will not blot his name out of the book
of life - Like that of the angel of the church at Sardis: but he shall
live forever. I will confess his name - As one of my faithful servants
and soldiers.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p6">7. The holy one, the true one - Two great and glorious
names He that hath the key of David - A master of a family, or a prince,
has one or more keys, wherewith he can open and shut all the doors of
his house or palace. So had David a key, a token of right and
sovereignty, which was afterward adjudged to Eliakim, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxii. 22" id="i.xxviii.iv-p6.1" parsed="|Isa|22|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.22.22">Isaiah xxii, 22</scripRef>. Much more has Christ, the Son of David, the key of the
spiritual city of David, the New Jerusalem; the supreme right, power,
and authority, as in his own house. He openeth this to all that
overcome, and none shutteth: he shutteth it against all the fearful, and
none openeth. Likewise when he openeth a door on earth for his works or
his servants, none can shut; and when he shutteth against whatever would
hurt or defile, none can open.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p7">8. I have given before thee an opened door - To enter into
the joy of thy Lord; and, meantime, to go on unhindered in every good
work. Thou hast a little strength - But little outward human strength; a
little, poor, mean, despicable company. Yet thou hast kept my word -
Both in judgment and practice.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p8">9. Behold, I - who have all power; and they must then
comply. I will make them come and bow down before thy feet - Pay thee
the lowest homage. And know - At length, that all depends on my love,
and that thou hast a place therein. O how often does the judgment of the
people turn quite round, when the Lord looketh upon them! <scripRef passage="Job xlii. 7" id="i.xxviii.iv-p8.1" parsed="|Job|42|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.42.7">Job xlii, 7</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p9">10. Because thou hast kept the word of my patience - The
word of Christ is indeed a word of patience. I also will keep thee - O
happy exemption from that spreading calamity! From the hour of
temptation - So that thou shalt not enter into temptation; but it shall
pass over thee. The hour denotes the short time of its continuance; that
is, at any one place. At every one it was very sharp, though short;
wherein the great tempter was not idle, chap. ii, 10. Which hour shall
come upon the whole earth - The whole Roman empire. It went over the
Christians, and over the Jews and heathens; though in a very different
manner. This was the time of the persecution under the seemingly
virtuous emperor Trajan. The two preceding persecutions were under those
monsters, Nero and Domitian; but Trajan was so admired for his goodness,
and his persecution was of such a nature, that it was a temptation
indeed, and did throughly try them that dwelt upon the earth.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p10">11. Thy crown - Which is ready for thee, if thou endure to
the end.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p11">12. I will make him a pillar in the temple of my God - I
will fix him as beautiful, as useful, and as immovable as a pillar in
the church of God. And he shall go out no more - But shall be holy and
happy forever. And I will write upon him the name of my God - So that
the nature and image of God shall appear visibly upon him. And the name
of the city of my God - Giving him a title to dwell in the New
Jerusalem. And my new name - A share in that joy which I entered into,
after overcoming all my enemies.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p12">14. To the angel of the church at Laodicea - For these St.
Paul had had a great concern, <scripRef passage="Colossians ii. 1" id="i.xxviii.iv-p12.1" parsed="|Col|2|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.2.1">Colossians ii, 1</scripRef>. These things saith the Amen - That is, the True One, the
God of truth. The beginning - The Author, Prince, and Ruler. Of the
creation of God - Of all creatures; the beginning, or Author, by whom
God made them all.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p13">15. I know thy works - Thy disposition and behaviour,
though thou knowest it not thyself. That thou art neither cold - An
utter stranger to the things of God, having no care or thought about
them. Nor hot - As boiling water: so ought we to be penetrated and
heated by the fire of love. O that thou wert - This wish of our Lord
plainly implies that he does not work on us irresistibly, as the fire
does on the water which it heats. Cold or hot - Even if thou wert cold,
without any thought or profession of religion, there would be more hope
of thy recovery.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p14">16. So because thou art lukewarm - The effect of lukewarm
water is well known. I am about to spue thee out of my mouth - I will
utterly cast thee from me; that is, unless thou repent.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p15">17. Because thou sayest - Therefore "I counsel thee,"
&amp;c. I am rich - In gifts and grace, as well as worldly goods. And
knowest not that thou art - In God's account, wretched and pitiable.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p16">18. I counsel thee - who art poor, and blind, and naked. To
buy of me - Without money or price. Gold purified in the fire - True,
living faith, which is purified in the furnace of affliction. And white
raiment - True holiness. And eyesalve - Spiritual illumination; the
"unction of the Holy One," which teacheth all things.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p17">19. Whomsoever I love - Even thee, thou poor Laodicean! O
how much has his unwearied love to do! I rebuke - For what is past. And
chasten - That they may amend for the time to come.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p18">20. I stand at the door, and knock - Even at this instant;
while he is speaking this word. If any man open - Willingly receive me.
I will sup with him - Refreshing him with my graces and gifts, and
delighting myself in what I have given. And he with me - In life
everlasting.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p19">21. I will give him to sit with me on my throne - In
unspeakable happiness and glory. Elsewhere, heaven itself is termed the
throne of God: but this throne is in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.iv-p20">22. He that hath an ear, let him hear, &amp;c. - This
stands in the three former letters before the promise; in the four
latter, after it; clearly dividing the seven into two parts; the first
containing three, the last, four letters. The titles given our Lord in
the three former letters peculiarly respect his power after his
resurrection and ascension, particularly over his church; those in the
four latter, his divine glory, and unity with the Father and the Holy
Spirit. Again, this word being placed before the promises in the three
former letters, excludes the false apostles at Ephesus, the false Jews
at Smyrna, and the partakers with the heathens at Pergamos, from having
any share therein. In the four latter, being placed after them, it
leaves the promises immediately joined with Christ's address to the
angel of the church, to show that the fulfilling of these was near;
whereas the others reach beyond the end of the world. It should be
observed, that the overcoming, or victory, (to which alone these
peculiar promises are annexed,) is not the ordinary victory obtained by
every believer; but a special victory over great and peculiar
temptations, by those that are strong in faith.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="26.89%" prev="i.xxviii.iv" next="i.xxviii.vi" id="i.xxviii.v">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.v-p0.1">IV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. IV" id="i.xxviii.v-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.4" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p1">We are now entering upon the main prophecy. The whole
Revelation may be divided thus:- The first, second, and third chapters
contain the introduction; The fourth and fifth, the proposition; The
sixth, seventh, eighth, and ninth describe things which are already
fulfilled; The tenth to the fourteenth, things which are now fulfilling;
The fifteenth to the nineteenth, things which will be fulfilled shortly;
The twentieth, twenty-first, and twenty-second, things at a greater
distance.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p2">1. After these things - As if he had said, After I had
written these letters from the mouth of the Lord. By the particle and,
the several parts of this prophecy are usually connected: by the
expression, after these things, they are distinguished from each other,
chap. vii, 9; xix, 1. By that expression, and after these things, they
are distinguished, and yet connected, chap. vii, 1; xv, 5; xviii, 1. St.
John always saw and heard, and then immediately wrote down one part
after another: and one part is constantly divided from another by some
one of these expressions. I saw - Here begins the relation of the main
vision, which is connected throughout; as it appears from "the throne,
and him that sitteth thereon;" "the Lamb;" (who hitherto has appeared in
the form of a man;) " the four living creatures;" and " the four and
twenty elders," represented from this place to the end. From this place,
it is absolutely necessary to keep in mind the genuine order of the
texts, as it stands in the preceding table. A door opened in heaven -
Several of these openings are successively mentioned. Here a door is
opened; afterward, "the temple of God in heaven," chap. xi, 19; xv, 5;
and, at last, "heaven" itself, xix, 11. By each of these St. John gains
a new and more extended prospect. And the first voice which I had heard
- Namely, that of Christ: afterward, he heard the voices of many others.
Said, Come up hither - Not in body, but in spirit; which was immediately
done.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p3">2. And immediately I was in the spirit - Even in an higher
degree than before, chap. i, 10. And, behold, a throne was set in heaven
- St. John is to write "things which shall be;" and, in order thereto,
he is here shown, after an heavenly manner, how whatever "shall be,"
whether good or bad, flows out of invisible fountains; and how, after it
is done on the visible theatre of the world and the church, it flows
back again into the invisible world, as its proper and final scope. Here
commentators divide: some proceed theologically; others, historically;
whereas the right way is, to join both together. The court of heaven is
here laid open; and the throne of God is, as it were, the center from
which everything in the visible world goes forth, and to which
everything returns. Here, also, the kingdom of Satan is disclosed; and
hence we may extract the most important things out of the most
comprehensive and, at the same time, most secret history of the kingdom
of hell and heaven. But herein we must be content to know only what is
expressly revealed in this book. This describes, not barely what good or
evil is successively transacted on earth, but how each springs from the
kingdom of light or darkness, and continually tends to the source whence
it sprung: So that no man can explain all that is contained therein,
from the history of the church militant only. And yet the histories of
past ages have their use, as this book is properly prophetical. The
more, therefore, we observe the accomplishment of it, so much the more
may we praise God, in his truth, wisdom, justice, and almighty power,
and learn to suit ourselves to the time, according to the remarkable
directions contained in the prophecy. And one sat on the throne - As a
king, governor, and judge. Here is described God, the Almighty, the
Father of heaven, in his majesty, glory, and dominion.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p4">3. And he that sat was in appearance - Shone with a visible
lustre, like that of sparkling precious stones, such as those which were
of old on the high priest's breastplate, and those placed as the
foundations of the new Jerusalem, chap. xxi, 19, 20. If there is
anything emblematical in the colours of these stones, possibly the
jasper, which is transparent and of a glittering white, with an
intermixture of beautiful colours, may be a symbol of God's purity, with
various other perfections, which shine in all his dispensations. The
sardine stone, of a blood-red colour, may be an emblem of his justice,
and the vengeance he was about to execute on his enemies. An emerald,
being green, may betoken favour to the good; a rainbow, the everlasting
covenant. See <scripRef passage="Gen. ix. 9" id="i.xxviii.v-p4.1" parsed="|Gen|9|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.9.9">Gen. ix, 9</scripRef>. And this being round about the whole breadth of the throne,
fixed the distance of those who stood or sat round it.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p5">4. And round about the throne - In a circle, are four and
twenty thrones, and on the thrones four and twenty elders - The most
holy of all the former ages, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxiv. 23" id="i.xxviii.v-p5.1" parsed="|Isa|24|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.24.23">Isaiah
xxiv, 23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Heb. xii. 1" id="i.xxviii.v-p5.2" parsed="|Heb|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.12.1">Heb. xii,
1</scripRef>; representing the whole body of the saints. Sitting - In
general; but falling down when they worship. Clothed in white raiment -
This and their golden crowns show, that they had already finished their
course and taken their place among the citizens of heaven. They are
never termed souls, and hence it is probable that they had glorified
bodies already. Compare <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvii. 52" id="i.xxviii.v-p5.3" parsed="|Matt|27|52|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.27.52">Matt. xxvii,
52</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p6">5. And out of the throne go forth lightnings - Which affect
the sight. Voices - Which affect the hearing. Thunderings - Which cause
the whole body to tremble. Weak men account all this terrible; but to
the inhabitants of heaven it is a mere source of joy and pleasure, mixed
with reverence to the Divine Majesty. Even to the saints on earth these
convey light and protection; but to their enemies, terror and
destruction.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p7">6. And before the throne is a sea as of glass, like crystal
- Wide and deep, pure and clear, transparent and still. Both the "seven
lamps of fire" and this sea are before the throne; and both may mean
"the seven spirits of God," the Holy Ghost; whose powers and operations
are frequently represented both under the emblem of fire and of water.
We read again, chap. xv, 2, of "a sea as of glass," where there is no
mention of "the seven lamps of fire;" but, on the contrary, the sea
itself is "mingled with fire." We read also, chap. xxii, 1, of "a stream
of water of life, clear as crystal." Now, the sea which is before the
throne, and the stream which goes out of the throne, may both mean the
same; namely, the Spirit of God. And in the midst of the throne - With
respect to its height. Round about the throne - That is, toward the four
quarters, east, west, north, and south. Were four living creatures - Not
beasts, no more than birds. These seem to be taken from the cherubim in
the visions of Isaiah and Ezekiel, and in the holy of holies. They are
doubtless some of the principal powers of heaven; but of what order, it
is not easy to determine. It is very probable that the twenty-four
elders may represent the Jewish church: their harps seem to intimate
their having belonged to the ancient tabernacle service, where they were
wont to be used. If so, the living creatures may represent the Christian
church. Their number, also, is symbolical of universality, and agrees
with the dispensation of the gospel, which extended to all nations under
heaven. And the "new song" which they all sing, saying, "Thou hast
redeemed us out of every kindred, and tongue, and people, and nation,"
chap. v, 9, could not possibly suit the Jewish without the Christian
church. The first living creature was like a lion - To signify undaunted
courage. The second, like a calf - Or ox, <scripRef passage="Ezek. i. 10" id="i.xxviii.v-p7.1" parsed="|Ezek|1|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.1.10">Ezek. i, 10</scripRef>, to signify unwearied patience. The third, with the face of
a man - To signify prudence and compassion. The fourth, like an eagle -
To signify activity and vigour. Full of eyes - To betoken wisdom and
knowledge. Before - To see the face of him that sitteth on the throne.
And behind - To see what is done among the creatures.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p8">7. And the first - Just such were the four cherubim in
Ezekiel, who supported the moving throne of God; whereas each of those
that overshadowed the mercy-seat in the holy of holies had all these
four faces: whence a late great man supposes them to have been
emblematic of the Trinity, and the incarnation of the second Person. A
flying eagle - That is, with wings expanded.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p9">8. Each of them hath six wings - As had each of the
seraphim in Isaiah's vision. "Two covered his face," in token of
humility and reverence: "two his feet," perhaps in token of readiness
and diligence for executing divine commissions. Round about and within
they are full of eyes. Round about - To see everything which is farther
off from the throne than they are themselves. And within - On the inner
part of the circle which they make with one another. First, they look
from the center to the circumference, then from the circumference to the
center. And they rest not - O happy unrest! Day and night - As we speak
on earth. But there is no night in heaven. And say, Holy, holy, holy -
Is the Three-One God. There are two words in the original, very
different from each other; both which we translate holy. The one means
properly merciful; but the other, which occurs here, implies much more.
This holiness is the sum of all praise, which is given to the almighty
Creator, for all that he does and reveals concerning himself, till the
new song brings with it new matter of glory. This word properly
signifies separated, both in Hebrew and other languages. And when God is
termed holy, it denotes that excellence which is altogether peculiar to
himself; and the glory flowing from all his attributes conjoined,
shining forth from all his works, and darkening all things besides
itself, whereby he is, and eternally remains, in an incomprehensible
manner separate and at a distance, not only from all that is impure, but
likewise from all that is created. God is separate from all things. He
is, and works from himself, out of himself, in himself, through himself,
for himself. Therefore, he is the first and the last, the only one and
the Eternal, living and happy, endless and unchangeable, almighty,
omniscient, wise and true, just and faithful, gracious and merciful.
Hence it is, that holy and holiness mean the same as God and Godhead:
and as we say of a king, "His Majesty;" so the scripture says of God,
"His Holiness," <scripRef passage="Heb. xii. 10" id="i.xxviii.v-p9.1" parsed="|Heb|12|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.12.10">Heb. xii,
10</scripRef>. The Holy Spirit is the Spirit of God. When God is spoken
of, he is often named "the Holy One:" and as God swears by his name, so
he does also by his holiness; that is, by himself. This holiness is
often styled glory: often his holiness and glory are celebrated
together, <scripRef passage="Lev. x. 3" id="i.xxviii.v-p9.2" parsed="|Lev|10|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.10.3">Lev. x, 3</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Isaiah vi. 3" id="i.xxviii.v-p9.3" parsed="|Isa|6|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.6.3">Isaiah vi, 3</scripRef>. For holiness is covered glory, and glory is uncovered
holiness. The scripture speaks abundantly of the holiness and glory of
the Father, the Son, and the Holy Ghost. And hereby is the mystery of
the Holy Trinity eminently confirmed. That is also termed holy which is
consecrated to him, and for that end separated from other things: and so
is that wherein we may be like God, or united to him. In the hymn
resembling this, recorded by Isaiah, <scripRef passage="Isaiah vi. 3" id="i.xxviii.v-p9.4" parsed="|Isa|6|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.6.3">Isaiah vi, 3</scripRef>, is added, "The whole earth is full of his glory." But this
is deferred in the Revelation, till the glory of the Lord (his enemies
being destroyed) fills the earth.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p10">9, 10. And when the living creatures give glory-the elders
fall down - That is, as often as the living creatures give glory,
immediately the elders fall down. The expression implies, that they did
so at the same instant, and that they both did this frequently. The
living creatures do not say directly, "Holy, holy, holy art thou;" but
only bend a little, out of deep reverence, and say, "Holy, holy, holy is
the Lord." But the elders, when they are fallen down, may say, "Worthy
art thou, O Lord our God."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.v-p11">11. Worthy art thou to receive - This he receives not only
when he is thus praised, but also when he destroys his enemies and
glorifies himself anew. The glory and the honour and the power -
Answering the thrice-holy of the living creatures, verse 9. ver. 9, For
thou hast created all things - Creation is the ground of all the works
of God: therefore, for this, as well as for his other works, will he be
praised to all eternity. And through thy will they were - They began to
be. It is to the free, gracious and powerfully- working will of Him who
cannot possibly need anything that all things owe their first existence.
And are created - That is, continue in being ever since they were
created.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="27.11%" prev="i.xxviii.v" next="i.xxviii.vii" id="i.xxviii.vi">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.vi-p0.1">V</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. V" id="i.xxviii.vi-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.5" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p1">1. And I saw - This is a continuation of the same
narrative. In the right hand - The emblem of his all-ruling power. He
held it openly, in order to give it to him that was worthy. It is scarce
needful to observe, that there is not in heaven any real book of
parchment or paper or that Christ does not really stand there, in the
shape of a lion or of a lamb. Neither is there on earth any monstrous
beast with seven heads and ten horns. But as there is upon earth
something which, in its kind, answers such a representation; so there
are in heaven divine counsels and transactions answerable to these
figurative expressions. All this was represented to St. John at Patmos,
in one day, by way of vision. But the accomplishment of it extends from
that time throughout all ages. Writings serve to inform us of distant
and of future things. And hence things which are yet to come are
figuratively said to be "written in God's book;" so were at that time
the contents of this weighty prophecy. But the book was sealed. Now
comes the opening and accomplishing also of the great things that are,
as it were, the letters of it. A book written within and without - That
is, no part of it blank, full of matter. Sealed with seven seals -
According to the seven principal parts contained in it, one on the
outside of each. The usual books of the ancients were not like ours, but
were volumes or long pieces of parchment, rolled upon a long stick, as
we frequently roll silks. Such was this represented, which was sealed
with seven seals. Not as if the apostle saw all the seals at once; for
there were seven volumes wrapped up one within another, each of which
was sealed: so that upon opening and unrolling the first, the second
appeared to be sealed up till that was opened, and so on to the seventh.
The book and its seals represent all power in heaven and earth given to
Christ. A copy of this book is contained in the following chapters. By
"the trumpets," contained under the seventh seal, the kingdom of the
world is shaken, that it may at length become the kingdom of Christ. By
"the vials," under the seventh trumpet, the power of the beast, and
whatsoever is connected with it, is broken. This sum of all we should
have continually before our eyes: so the whole Revelation flows in its
natural order.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p2">2. And I saw a strong angel - This proclamation to every
creature was too great for a man to make, and yet not becoming the Lamb
himself. It was therefore made by an angel, and one of uncommon
eminence.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p3">3. And none - No creature; no, not Mary herself. In heaven,
or in earth, neither under the earth - That is, none in the universe.
For these are the three great regions into which the whole creation is
divided. Was able to open the book - To declare the counsels of God. Nor
to look thereon - So as to understand any part of it.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p4">4. And I wept much - A weeping which sprung from greatness
of mind. The tenderness of heart which he always had appeared more
clearly now he was out of his own power. The Revelation was not written
without tears; neither without tears will it be understood. How far are
they from the temper of St. John who inquire after anything rather than
the contents of this book! yea, who applaud their own clemency if they
excuse those that do inquire into them!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p5">5. And one of the elders - Probably one of those who rose
with Christ, and afterwards ascended into heaven. Perhaps one of the
patriarchs. Some think it was Jacob, from whose prophecy the name of
Lion is given him, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 9" id="i.xxviii.vi-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|49|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.9">Gen. xlix,
9</scripRef>. The Lion of the tribe of Judah - The victorious prince who
is, like a lion, able to tear all his enemies in pieces. The root of
David - As God, the root and source of David's family, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xi. 1, 10" id="i.xxviii.vi-p5.2" parsed="|Isa|11|1|0|0;|Isa|11|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.11.1 Bible:Isa.11.10">Isaiah xi, 1, 10</scripRef>. Hath prevailed to open the book - Hath overcome all
obstructions, and obtained the honour to disclose the divine
counsels.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p6">6. And I saw - First, Christ in or on the midst of the
throne; secondly, the four living creatures making the inner circle
round him; and, thirdly, the four and twenty elders making a larger
circle round him and them. Standing - He lieth no more; he no more falls
on his face; the days of his weakness and mourning are ended. He is now
in a posture of readiness to execute all his offices of prophet, priest,
and king. As if he had been slain - Doubtless with the prints of the
wounds which he once received. And because he was slain, he is worthy to
open the book, verse 9, to the joy of his own people, and the terror of
his enemies. Having seven horns - As a king, the emblem of perfect
strength. And seven eyes - The emblem of perfect knowledge and wisdom.
By these he accomplishes what is contained in the book, namely, by his
almighty and all-wise Spirit. To these seven horns and seven eyes answer
the seven seals and the sevenfold song of praise, verse 12. In
Zechariah, likewise, iii, 9; iv, 10. <scripRef passage="Zech. iii. 9" id="i.xxviii.vi-p6.1" parsed="|Zech|3|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.3.9">Zech. iii, 9</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Zech. iv. 10" id="i.xxviii.vi-p6.2" parsed="|Zech|4|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.4.10">Zech. iv, 10</scripRef> mention is made of "the seven eyes of the Lord, which go
forth over all the earth." Which - Both the horns and the eyes. Are the
seven spirits of God sent forth into all the earth - For the effectual
working of the Spirit of God goes through the whole creation; and that
in the natural, as well as spiritual, world. For could mere matter act
or move? Could it gravitate or attract? Just as much as it can think or
speak.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p7">7. And he came - Here was "Ask of me," <scripRef passage="Psalm ii. 8" id="i.xxviii.vi-p7.1" parsed="|Ps|2|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.2.8">Psalm ii, 8</scripRef>, fulfilled in the most glorious manner. And took - it is one
state of exaltation that reaches from our Lord's ascension to his coming
in glory. Yet this state admits of various degrees. At his ascension,
"angels, and principalities, and powers were subjected to him." Ten days
after, he received from the Father and sent the Holy Ghost. And now he
took the book out of the right hand of him that sat upon the throne -
who gave it him as a signal of his delivering to him all power in heaven
and earth. He received it, in token of his being both able and willing
to fulfil all that was written therein.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p8">8. And when he took the book, the four living creatures
fell down - Now is homage done to the Lamb by every creature. These,
together with the elders, make the beginning; and afterward, chap. v,
14, the conclusion. They are together surrounded with a multitude of
angels, chap. v, 11, and together sing the new song, as they had before
praised God together, chap. iv, 8, &amp;c. Having every one - The
elders, not the living creatures. An harp - Which was one of the chief
instruments used for thanksgiving in the temple service: a fit emblem of
the melody of their hearts. And golden phials - Cups or censers. Full of
incense, which are the prayers of the saints - Not of the elders
themselves, but of the other saints still upon earth, whose prayers were
thus emblematically represented in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p9">9. And they sing a new song - One which neither they nor
any other had sung before. Thou hast redeemed us - So the living
creatures also were of the number of the redeemed. This does not so much
refer to the act of redemption, which was long before, as to the fruit
of it; and so more directly to those who had finished their course, "who
were redeemed from the earth," ver. 1, out of every tribe, and tongue,
and people, and nation - That is, out of all mankind.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p10">10. And hast made them - The redeemed. So they speak of
themselves also in the third person, out of deep self-abasement. They
shall reign over the earth - The new earth: herewith agree the golden
crowns of the elders. The reign of the saints in general follows, under
the trumpet of the seventh angel; particularly after the first
resurrection, as also in eternity, chap. xi, 18; xv, 7; xx, 4; xxii, 5;<scripRef passage="Dan. vii. 27" id="i.xxviii.vi-p10.1" parsed="|Dan|7|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.7.27">Dan. vii, 27</scripRef>;<scripRef passage="Psalm xlix. 14" id="i.xxviii.vi-p10.2" parsed="|Ps|49|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.49.14">Psalm xlix, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p11">11. And I saw - The many angels. And heard - The voice and
the number of them. Round about the elders - So forming the third
circle. It is remarkable, that men are represented through this whole
vision as nearer to God than any of the angels. And the number of them
was - At least two hundred millions, and two millions over. And yet
these were but a part of the holy angels. Afterward, chap. vii, 11, St.
John heard them all.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p12">12. Worthy is the Lamb - The elders said, ver. 9, "Worthy
art thou." They were more nearly allied to him than the angels. To
receive the power, &amp;c. - This sevenfold applause answers the seven
seals, of which the four former describe all visible, the latter all
invisible, things, made subject to the Lamb. And every one of these
seven words bears a resemblance to the seal which it answers.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vi-p13">13. And every creature - In the whole universe, good or
bad. In the heaven, on the earth, under the earth, on the sea - With
these four regions of the world, agrees the fourfold word of praise.
What is in heaven, says blessing; what is on earth, honour; what is
under the earth, glory: what is on the sea, strength; is unto him. This
praise from all creatures begins before the opening of the first seal;
but it continues from that time to eternity, according to the capacity
of each. His enemies must acknowledge his glory; but those in heaven
say, Blessed be God and the Lamb. This royal manifesto is, as it were, a
proclamation, showing how Christ fulfils all things, and "every knee
bows to him," not only on earth, but also in heaven, and under the
earth. This book exhausts all things, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. xv. 27, 28" id="i.xxviii.vi-p13.1" parsed="|1Cor|15|27|15|28" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.15.27-1Cor.15.28">1 Cor. xv, 27, 28</scripRef>, and is suitable to an heart enlarged as the sand of the
sea. It inspires the attentive and intelligent reader with such a
magnanimity, that he accounts nothing in this world great; no, not the
whole frame of visible nature, compared to the immense greatness of what
he is here called to behold, yea, and in part, to inherit. St. John has
in view, through the whole following vision, what he has been now
describing, namely, the four living creatures, the elders, the angels,
and all creatures, looking together at the opening of the seven
seals.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="27.29%" prev="i.xxviii.vi" next="i.xxviii.viii" id="i.xxviii.vii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.vii-p0.1">VI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. VI" id="i.xxviii.vii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.6" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p1">The seven seals are not distinguished from each other by
specifying the time of them. They swiftly follow the letters to the
seven churches, and all begin almost at the same time. By the four
former is shown, that all the public occurrences of all ages and
nations, as empire, war, provision, calamities, are made subject to
Christ. And instances are intimated of the first in the east, the second
in the west, the third in the south, the fourth in the north and the
whole world. The contents, as of the phials and trumpets, so of the
seals, are shown by the songs of praise and thanksgiving annexed to
them. They contain therefore "the power, and riches, and wisdom, and
strength, and honour, and glory, and blessing," which the Lamb received.
The four former have a peculiar connection with each other; and so have
the three latter seals. The former relate to visible things, toward the
four quarters to which the four living creatures look. Before we
proceed, it may be observed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.vii-p2">1. No man should constrain either himself or
another to explain everything in this book. It is sufficient for every
one to speak just so far as he understands.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.vii-p3">2. We should remember that, although the
ancient prophets wrote the occurrences of those kingdoms only with which
Israel had to do, yet the Revelation contains what relates to the whole
world, through which the Christian church is extended. Yet,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.vii-p4">3. We should not prescribe to this prophecy,
as if it must needs admit or exclude this or that history, according as
we judge one or the other to be of great or small importance. "God seeth
not as a man seeth;" therefore what we think great is often omitted,
what we think little inserted, in scripture history or prophecy.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.vii-p5">4. We must take care not to overlook what is
already fulfilled; and not to describe as fulfilled what is still to
come. We are to look in history for the fulfilling of the four first
seals, quickly after the date of the prophecy. In each of these appears
a different horseman. In each we are to consider, first, the horseman
himself; secondly, what he does. The horseman himself, by an
emblematical prosopopoeia, represents a swift power, bringing with it
either,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.vii-p6">1. A flourishing state; or,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.vii-p7">2. Bloodshed; or,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.vii-p8">3. Scarcity of provisions; or,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.vii-p9">4. Public calamities. With the quality of
each of these riders the colour of his horse agrees. The fourth horseman
is expressly termed "death;" the first, with his bow and crown, "a
conqueror;" the second, with his great sword, is a warrior, or, as the
Roman termed him, Mars; the third, with the scales, has power over the
produce of the land. Particular incidents under this or that Roman
emperor are not extensive enough to answer any of these horsemen. The
action of every horseman intimates farther,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.vii-p10">1. Toward the east, wide spread empire, and
victory upon victory:</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.vii-p11">2. Toward the west, much bloodshed:</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.vii-p12">3. Toward the south, scarcity of
provisions:</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.vii-p13">4. Toward the north, the plague and various
calamities.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p14">1. I heard one-That is, the first. Of the living creatures
- Who looks forward toward the east.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p15">2. And I saw, and behold a white horse, and he that sat on
him had a bow - This colour, and the bow shooting arrows afar off,
betoken victory, triumph, prosperity, enlargement of empire, and
dominion over many people. Another horseman, indeed, and of quite
another kind, appears on a white horse, chap. xix, 11. But he that is
spoken of under the first seal must be so understood as to bear a
proportion to the horsemen in the second, third, and fourth seal. Nerva
succeeded the emperor Domitian at the very time when the Revelation was
written, in the year of our Lord 96. He reigned scarce a year alone; and
three months before his death he named Trajan for his colleague and
successor, and died in the year 98. Trajan's accession to the empire
seems to be the dawning of the seven seals. And a crown was given him -
This, considering his descent, Trajan could have no hope of attaining.
But God gave it him by the hand of Nerva; and then the east soon felt
his power. And he went forth conquering and to conquer - That is, from
one victory to another. In the year 108 the already victorious Trajan
went forth toward the east, to conquer not only Armenia, Assyria, and
Mesopotamia, but also the countries beyond the Tigris, carrying the
bounds of the Roman empire to a far greater extent than ever. We find no
emperor like him for making conquests. He aimed at nothing else; he
lived only to conquer. Meantime, in him was eminently fulfilled what had
been prophesied of the fourth empire, <scripRef passage="Dan. ii. 40" id="i.xxviii.vii-p15.1" parsed="|Dan|2|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.2.40">Dan. ii, 40</scripRef>, vii, 23, that he should "devour, tread down, and break in
pieces the whole earth."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p16">3. And when he had opened the second seal, I heard the
second living creature - Who looked toward the west. Saying, Come - At
each seal it was necessary to turn toward that quarter of the world
which it more immediately concerned.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p17">4. There went forth another horse that was red - A colour
suitable to bloodshed. And to him that sat thereon it was given to take
peace from the earth - Vespasian, in the year 75, had dedicated a temple
to Peace; but after a time we hear little more of peace. All is full of
war and bloodshed, chiefly in the western world, where the main business
of men seemed to be, to kill one another. To this horseman there was
given a great sword; and he had much to do with it; for as soon as
Trajan ascended the throne, peace was taken from the earth. Decebalus,
king of Dacia, which lies westward from Patmos, put the Roman to no
small trouble. The war lasted five years, and consumed abundance of men
on both sides; yet was only a prelude to much other bloodshed, which
followed for a long season. All this was signified by the great sword,
which strikes those who are near, as the bow does those who are at a
distance.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p18">5. And when he had opened the third seal, I heard the third
living creature - Toward the south. Saying, Come. And behold a black
horse - A fit emblem of mourning and distress; particularly of black
famine, as the ancient poets term it. And he that sat on him had a pair
of scales in his hand - When there is great plenty, men scarce think it
worth their while to weigh and measure everything, <scripRef passage="Gen. xli. 49" id="i.xxviii.vii-p18.1" parsed="|Gen|41|49|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.41.49">Gen. xli, 49</scripRef>. But when there is scarcity, they are obliged to deliver
them out by measure and weight, <scripRef passage="Ezek. iv. 16" id="i.xxviii.vii-p18.2" parsed="|Ezek|4|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.4.16">Ezek. iv, 16</scripRef>. Accordingly, these scales signify scarcity. They serve also
for a token, that all the fruits of the earth, and consequently the
whole heavens, with their courses and influences; that all the seasons
of the year, with whatsoever they produce, in nature or states, are
subject to Christ. Accordingly his hand is wonderful, not only in wars
and victories, but likewise in the whole course of nature.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p19">6. And I heard a voice - It seems, from God himself. Saying
- To the horseman, "Hitherto shalt thou come, and no farther." Let there
be a measure of wheat for a penny - The word translated measure, was a
Grecian measure, nearly equal to our quart. This was the daily allowance
of a slave. The Roman penny, as much as a labourer then earned in a day,
was about sevenpence halfpenny English. According to this, wheat would
be near twenty shillings per bushel. This must have been fulfilled while
the Grecian measure and the Roman money were still in use; as also where
that measure was the common measure, and this money the current coin. It
was so in Egypt under Trajan. And three measures of barley for a penny -
Either barley was, in common, far cheaper among the ancients than wheat,
or the prophecy mentions this as something peculiar. And hurt not the
oil and the wine - Let there not be a scarcity of everything. Let there
be some provision left to supply the want of the rest This was also
fulfilled in the reign of Trajan, especially in Egypt, which lay
southward from Patmos. In this country, which used to be the granary of
the empire, there was an uncommon dearth at the very beginning of his
reign; so that he was obliged to supply Egypt itself with corn from
other countries. The same scarcity there was in the thirteenth year of
his reign, the harvest failing for want of the rising of the Nile: and
that not only in Egypt, but in all those other parts of Afric, where the
Nile uses to overflow.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p20">7. I heard the voice of the fourth living creature - Toward
the north.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p21">8. And I saw, and behold a pale horse - Suitable to pale
death, his rider. And hades - The representative of the state of
separate souls. Followeth even with him - The four first seals concern
living men. Death therefore is properly introduced. Hades is only
occasionally mentioned as a companion of death. So the fourth seal
reaches to the borders of things invisible, which are comprised in the
three last seals. And power was given to him over the fourth part of the
earth - What came single and in a lower degree before, comes now
together, and much more severely. The first seal brought victory with
it: in the second was "a great sword;" but here a scimitar. In the third
was moderate dearth; here famine, and plague, and wild beasts beside.
And it may well be, that from the time of Trajan downwards, the fourth
part of men upon the earth, that is, within the Roman empire, died by
sword, famine, pestilence, and wild beasts. "At that time," says
Aurelius Victor, "the Tyber overflowed much more fatally than under
Nerva, with a great destruction of houses and there was a dreadful
earthquake through many provinces, and a terrible plague and famine, and
many places consumed by fire." By death - That is, by pestilence wild
beasts have, at several times, destroyed abundance of men; and
undoubtedly there was given them, at this time, an uncommon fierceness
and strength. It is observable that war brings on scarcity, and scarcity
pestilence, through want of wholesome sustenance; and pestilence, by
depopulating the country, leaves the few survivors an easier prey to the
wild beasts. And thus these judgments make way for one another in the
order wherein they are here represented. What has been already observed
may be a fourfold proof that the four horsemen, as with their first
entrance in the reign of Trajan, (which does by no means exhaust the
contents of the four first seals,) so with all their entrances in
succeeding ages, and with the whole course of the world and of visible
nature, are in all ages subject to Christ, subsisting by his power, and
serving his will, against the wicked, and in defense of the righteous.
Herewith, likewise, a way is paved for the trumpets which regularly
succeed each other; and the whole prophecy, as to what is future, is
confirmed by the clear accomplishment of this part of it.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p22">9. And when he opened the fifth seal - As the four former
seals, so the three latter, have a close connection with each other.
These all refer to the invisible world; the fifth, to the happy dead,
particularly the martyrs; the sixth, to the unhappy; the seventh, to the
angels, especially those to whom the trumpets are given. And I saw - Not
only the church warring under Christ, and the world warring under Satan;
but also the invisible hosts, both of heaven and hell, are described in
this book. And it not only describes the actions of both these armies
upon earth; but their respective removals from earth, into a more happy
or more miserable state, succeeding each other at several times,
distinguished by various degrees, celebrated by various thanksgivings;
and also the gradual increase of expectation and triumph in heaven, and
of terror and misery in hell. Under the altar - That is, at the foot of
it. Two altars are mentioned in the Revelation, "the golden altar" of
incense, chap. ix, 13; and the altar of burnt-offerings, mentioned here,
and chap. viii, 5, xiv, 18, xvi, 7. At this the souls of the martyrs now
prostrate themselves. By and by their blood shall be avenged upon
Babylon; but not yet, whence it appears that the plagues in the fourth
seal do not concern Rome in particular.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p23">10. And they cried - This cry did not begin now, but under
the first Roman persecution. The Roman themselves had already avenged
the martyrs slain by the Jews on that whole nation. How long - They knew
their blood would be avenged; but not immediately, as is now shown them.
O Lord - The Greek word properly signifies the master of a family: it is
therefore beautifully used by these, who are peculiarly of the household
of God. Thou Holy One and true - Both the holiness and truth of God
require him to execute judgment and vengeance. Dost thou not judge and
avenge our blood? - There is no impure affection in heaven: therefore,
this desire of theirs is pure and suitable to the will of God. The
martyrs are concerned for the praise of their Master, of his holiness
and truth: and the praise is given him, chap. xix, 2, where the prayer
of the martyrs is changed into a thanksgiving:- Thou holy One and true:
"True and right are thy judgments." How long dost thou not judge "He
hath judged the great whore, and avenge our blood? and hath avenged the
blood of his servants."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p24">11. And there was given to every one a white robe - An
emblem of innocence, joy, and victory, in token of honour and favourable
acceptance. And it was said to them - They were told how long. They were
not left in that uncertainty. That they should rest - Should cease from
crying. They rested from pain before. A time - This word has a peculiar
meaning in this book, to denote which, we may retain the original word
chronos. Here are two classes of martyrs specified, the former killed
under heathen Rome, the latter, under papal Rome. The former are
commanded to rest till the latter are added to them. There were many of
the former in the days of John: the first fruits of the latter died in
the thirteenth century. Now, a time, or chronos, is 1111 years. This
chronos began A. 98, and continued to the year 1209; or from Trajan's
persecution, to the first crusade against the Waldenses. Till - It is
not said, Immediately after this time is expired, vengeance shall be
executed; but only, that immediately after this time their brethren and
fellowservants will come to them. This event will precede the other; and
there will be some space between.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p25">12. And I saw - This sixth seal seems particularly to point
out God's judgment on the wicked departed. St. John saw how the end of
the world was even then set before those unhappy spirits. This
representation might be made to them, without anything of it being
perceived upon earth. The like representation is made in heaven, chap.
xi, 18. And there was a great earthquake - Or shaking, not of the earth
only, but the heavens. This is a farther description of the
representation made to those unhappy souls.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p26">13. And the stars fell to, or towards, the earth - Yea, and
so they surely will, let astronomers fix their magnitude as they please.
As a fig tree casteth its untimely figs, when it is shaken by a mighty
wind - How sublimely is the violence of that shaking expressed by this
comparison!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p27">14. And the heavens departed as a book that is rolled
together - When the scripture compares some very great with a little
thing, the majesty and omnipotence of God, before whom great things are
little, is highly exalted. Every mountain and island - What a mountain
is to the land, that an island is to the sea.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p28">15. And the kings of the earth - They who had been so in
their day. And the great men and chief captains - The generals and
nobles. Hid themselves - So far as in them lay. In the rocks of the
mountains - There are also rocks on the plains; but they were rocks on
high, which they besought to fall upon them.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.vii-p29">16. To the mountains and the rocks - Which were tottering
already, verse</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="27.56%" prev="i.xxviii.vii" next="i.xxviii.ix" id="i.xxviii.viii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.viii-p0.1">VII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. VII" id="i.xxviii.viii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.7" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p1">1. And after these things - What follows is a preparation
for the seventh seal, which is the weightiest of all. It is connected
with the sixth by the particle and; whereas what is added, verse 9,
stands free and unconnected. I saw four angels - Probably evil ones.
They have their employ with the four first trumpets, as have other evil
angels with the three last; namely, the angel of the abyss, the four
bound in the Euphrates, and Satan himself. These four angels would
willingly have brought on all the calamities that follow without delay.
But they were restrained till the servants of God were sealed, and till
the seven angels were ready to sound: even as the angel of the abyss was
not let loose, nor the angels in the Euphrates unbound, neither Satan
cast to the earth, till the fifth, sixth, and seventh angels severally
sounded. Standing on the four corners of the earth - East, west, south,
north. In this order proceed the four first trumpets. Holding the four
winds - Which else might have softened the fiery heat, under the first,
second, and third trumpet. That the wind should not blow upon the earth,
nor on the sea, nor on any tree - It seems, that these expressions
betoken the several quarters of the world; that the earth signifies that
to the east of Patmos, Asia, which was nearest to St. John, and where
the trumpet of the first angel had its accomplishment. Europe swims in
the sea over against this; and is accordingly termed by the prophets,
"the islands." The third part, Africa, seems to be meant, chap. viii, 7,
8, 10, by "the streams of water," or "the trees," which grow plentifully
by them.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p2">2. And I saw another (a good) angel ascending from the east
- The plagues begin in the east; so does the sealing. Having the seal of
the only living and true God: and he cried with a loud voice to the four
angels - Who were hasting to execute their charge. To whom it was given
to hurt the earth and the sea - First, and afterwards "the trees."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p3">3. Hurt not the earth, till we - Other angels were joined
in commission with him. Have sealed the servants of our God on their
foreheads - Secured the servants of God of the twelve tribes from the
impending calamities; whereby they shall be as clearly distinguished
from the rest, as if they were visibly marked on their foreheads.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p4">4. Of the children of Israel - To these will afterwards be
joined a multitude out of all nations. But it may be observed, this is
not the number of all the Israelites who are saved from Abraham or Moses
to the end of all things; but only of those who were secured from the
plagues which were then ready to fall on the earth. It seems as if this
book had, in many places, a special view to the people of Israel.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p5">5. Judah is mentioned first, in respect of the kingdom, and
of the Messiah sprung therefrom.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p6">7. After the Levitical ceremonies were abolished, Levi was
again on a level with his brethren.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p7">8. Of the tribe of Joseph - Or Ephraim; perhaps not
mentioned by name, as having been, with Daniel, the most idolatrous of
all the tribes. It is farther observable of Daniel, that it was very
early reduced to a single family; which family itself seems to have been
cut off in war, before the time of Ezra; for in the Chronicles, where
the posterity of the patriarchs is recited, Dan. is wholly omitted.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p8">9. A great multitude - Of those who had happily finished
their course. Such multitudes are afterwards described, and still higher
degrees of glory which they attain after a sharp fight and magnificent
victory, chap. xiv, 1; xv, 2; xix, 1; xx, 4. There is an inconceivable
variety in the degrees of reward in the other world. Let not any
slothful one say, "If I get to heaven at all, I will be content:" such
an one may let heaven go altogether. In worldly things, men are
ambitious to get as high as they can. Christians have a far more noble
ambition. The difference between the very highest and the lowest state
in the world is nothing to the smallest difference between the degrees
of glory. But who has time to think of this? Who is at all concerned
about it? Standing before the throne - In the full vision of God. And
palms in their hands - Tokens of joy and victory.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p9">10. Salvation to our God - Who hath saved us from all evil
into all the happiness of heaven. The salvation for which they praise
God is described, verse 15; that for which they praise the Lamb, verse
14; and both, in the sixteenth and seventeenth verses. ver. 16, 17</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p10">11. And all the angels stood - In waiting. Round about the
throne, and the elders and the four living creatures - That is, the
living creatures, next the throne; the elders, round these; and the
angels, round them both. And they fell on their faces - So do the
elders, once only, chap. xi, 16. The heavenly ceremonial has its fixed
order and measure.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p11">12. Amen - With this word all the angels confirm the words
of the "great multitude;" but they likewise carry the praise much
higher. The blessing, and the glory, and the wisdom, and the
thanksgiving, and the honour, and the power, and the strength, be unto
our God forever and ever - Before the Lamb began to open the seven
seals, a sevenfold hymn of praise was brought him by many angels, chap.
v, 12. Now he is upon opening the last seal, and the seven angels are
going to receive seven trumpets, in order to make the kingdoms of the
world subject to God. All the angels give sevenfold praise to God.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p12">13. And one of the elders - What stands, verses 13-17, ver.
13-17 might have immediately followed the tenth verse; but that the
praise of the angels, which was at the same time with that of the "great
multitude," came in between. Answered - He answered St. John's desire to
know, not any words that he spoke.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p13">14. My Lord - Or, my master; a common term of respect. So
Zechariah, likewise, bespeaks the angel, <scripRef passage="Zech. i. 9; iv. 4; vi. 4" id="i.xxviii.viii-p13.1" parsed="|Zech|1|9|0|0;|Zech|4|4|0|0;|Zech|6|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.1.9 Bible:Zech.4.4 Bible:Zech.6.4">Zech. i, 9; iv, 4; vi,
4</scripRef>. Thou knowest - That is, I know not; but thou dost. These
are they - Not martyrs; for these are not such a multitude as no man can
number. But as all the angels appear here, so do all the souls of the
righteous who had lived from the beginning of the world. Who come - He
does not say, who did come; but, who come now also: to whom, likewise,
pertain all who will come hereafter. Out of great affliction - Of
various kinds, wisely and graciously allotted by God to all his
children. And have washed their robes - From all guilt. And made them
white - In all holiness. By the blood of the Lamb - Which not only
cleanses, but adorns us also.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p14">15. Therefore - Because they came out of great affliction,
and have washed their robes in his blood. Are they before the throne -
It seems, even nearer than the angels. And serve him day and night -
Speaking after the manner of men; that is, continually. In his temple -
Which is in heaven. And he shall have his tent over them - Shall spread
his glory over them as a covering.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p15">16. Neither shall the sun light on them - For God is there
their sun. Nor any painful heat, or inclemency of seasons.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.viii-p16">17. For the Lamb will feed them - With eternal peace and
joy; so that they shall hunger no more. And will lead them to living
fountains of water - The comforts of the Holy Ghost; so that they shall
thirst no more. Neither shall they suffer or grieve any more; for God
"will wipe away all tears from their eyes."</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="27.69%" prev="i.xxviii.viii" next="i.xxviii.x" id="i.xxviii.ix">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.ix-p0.1">VIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. VIII" id="i.xxviii.ix-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.8" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p1">1. And when he had opened the seventh seal, there was
silence in heaven - Such a silence is mentioned but in this one place.
It was uncommon, and highly observable: for praise is sounding in heaven
day and night. In particular, immediately before this silence, all the
angels, and before them the innumerable multitude, had been crying with
a loud voice; and now all is still at once: there is an universal pause.
Hereby the seventh seal is very remarkably distinguished from the six
preceding. This silence before God shows that those who were round about
him were expecting, with the deepest reverence, the great things which
the Divine Majesty would farther open and order. Immediately after, the
seven trumpets are heard, and a sound more august than ever. Silence is
only a preparation: the grand point is, the sounding the trumpets to the
praise of God. About half an hour - To St. John, in the vision, it might
seem a common half hour.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p2">2. And I saw - The seven trumpets belong to the seventh
seal, as do the seven phials to the seventh trumpet. This should be
carefully remembered, that we may not confound together the times which
follow each other. And yet it may be observed, in general, concerning
the times of the incidents mentioned in this book, it is not a certain
rule, that every part of the text is fully accomplished before the
completion of the following part begins. All things mentioned in the
epistles are not full accomplished before the seals are opened; neither
are all things mentioned under the seals fulfilled before the trumpets
begin; nor yet is the seventh trumpet wholly past before the phials are
poured out. Only the beginning of each part goes before the beginning of
the following. Thus the epistles begin before the seals, the seals
before the trumpets, the trumpets before the phials. One epistle begins
before another, one seal before another, one trumpet especially before
another, one phial before another. Yet, sometimes, what begins later
than another thing ends sooner; and what begins earlier than another
thing ends later: so the seventh trumpet begins earlier than the phials,
and yet extends beyond them all. The seven angels which stood before God
- A character of the highest eminence. And seven trumpets were given
them. - When men desire to make known openly a thing of public concern,
they give a token that may be seen or heard far and wide; and, among
such, none are more ancient than trumpets, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxv. 9" id="i.xxviii.ix-p2.1" parsed="|Lev|25|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.25.9">Lev. xxv, 9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Num. x. 2" id="i.xxviii.ix-p2.2" parsed="|Num|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.10.2">Num. x, 2</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Amos iii. 6" id="i.xxviii.ix-p2.3" parsed="|Amos|3|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Amos.3.6">Amos iii, 6</scripRef>. The Israelites, in particular, used them, both in the
worship of God and in war; therewith openly praising the power of God
before, after, and in, the battle, <scripRef passage="Josh. vi. 4" id="i.xxviii.ix-p2.4" parsed="|Josh|6|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.6.4">Josh. vi, 4</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xiii. 14" id="i.xxviii.ix-p2.5" parsed="|2Chr|13|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.13.14">2 Chron. xiii, 14</scripRef>, &amp;c. And the angels here made known by these trumpets
the wonderful works of God, whereby all opposing powers are successively
shaken, till the kingdom of the world becomes the kingdom of God and his
Anointed. These trumpets reach nearly from the time of St. John to the
end of the world; and they are distinguished by manifest tokens. The
place of the four first is specified; namely, east, west, south, and
north successively: in the three last, immediately after the time of
each, the place likewise is pointed out. The seventh angel did not begin
to sound, till after the going forth of the second woe: but the trumpets
were given to him and the other six together; (as were afterward the
phials to the seven angels;) and it is accordingly said of all the seven
together, that "they prepared themselves to sound." These, therefore,
were not men, as some have thought, but angels, properly so called.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p3">3. And - In the second verse, the "trumpets were given" to
the seven angels; and in the sixth, they "prepared to sound." But
between these, the incense of this angel and the prayers of the saints
are mentioned; the interposing of which shows, that the prayers of the
saints and the trumpets of the angels go together: and these prayers,
with the effects of them, may well be supposed to extend through all the
seven. Another angel - Another created angel. Such are all that are here
spoken of. In this part of the Revelation, Christ is never termed an
angel; but, "the Lamb." Came and stood at the altar - Of
burnt-offerings. And there was given him a golden censer - A censer was
a cup on a plate or saucer. This was the token and the business of the
office. And much incense was given-Incense generally signifies prayer:
here it signifies the longing desires of the angels, that the holy
counsel of God might be fulfilled. And there was much incense; for as
the prayers of all the saints in heaven and earth are here joined
together: so are the desires of all the angels which are brought by this
angel. That he might place it - It is not said, offer it; for he was
discharging the office of an angel, not a priest. With the prayers of
all the saints - At the same time; but not for the saints. The angels
are fellowservants with the saints, not mediators for them.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p4">4. And the smoke of the incense came up before God, with
the prayers of the saints - A token that both were accepted.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p5">5. And there were thunderings, and lightnings, and voices,
and an earthquake - These, especially when attended with fire, are
emblems of God's dreadful judgments, which are immediately to
follow.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p6">6. And the seven angels prepared themselves to sound - That
each, when it should come to his turn, might sound without delay. But
while they do sound, they still stand before God.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p7">7. And the first sounded - And every angel continued to
sound, till all which his trumpet brought was fulfilled and till the
next began. There are intervals between the three woes, but not between
the four first trumpets. And there was hail and fire mingled with blood,
and there were cast upon the earth - The earth seems to mean Asia;
Palestine, in particular. Quickly after the Revelation was given, the
Jewish calamities under Adrian began: yea, before the reign of Trajan
was ended. And here the trumpets begin. Even under Trajan, in the year
114, the Jews made an insurrection with a most dreadful fury; and in the
parts about Cyrene, in Egypt, and in Cyprus, destroyed four hundred and
sixty thousand persons. But they were repressed by the victorious power
of Trajan, and afterward slaughtered themselves in vast multitudes. The
alarm spread itself also into Mesopotamia, where Lucius Quintius slew a
great number of them. They rose in Judea again in the second year of
Adrian; but were presently quelled. Yet in 133 they broke out more
violently than ever, under their false messiah Barcochab; and the war
continued till the year 135, when almost all Judea was desolated. In the
Egyptian plague also hail and fire were together. But here hail is to be
taken figuratively, as also blood, for a vehement, sudden, powerful,
hurtful invasion; and fire betokens the revenge of an enraged enemy,
with the desolation therefrom. And they were cast upon the earth - That
is, the fire and hail and blood. But they existed before they were cast
upon the earth. The storm fell, the blood flowed, and the flames raged
round Cyrene, and in Egypt, and Cyprus, before they reached Mesopotamia
and Judea. And the third part of the earth was burnt up - Fifty well-
fortified cities, and nine hundred and eighty-five well-inhabited towns
of the Jews, were wholly destroyed in this war. Vast tracts of land were
likewise left desolate and without inhabitant. And the third part of the
trees was burned up, and all the green grass was burned up - Some
understand by the trees, men of eminence among the Jews; by the grass,
the common people. The Roman spared many of the former: the latter were
almost all destroyed. Thus vengeance began at the Jewish enemies of
Christ's kingdom; though even then the Roman did not quite escape. But
afterwards it came upon them more and more violently: the second trumpet
affects the Roman heathens in particular; the third, the dead, unholy
Christians; the fourth, the empire itself.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p8">8. And the second angel sounded, and as it were a great
mountain burning with fire was cast into the sea - By the sea,
particularly as it is here opposed to the earth, we may understand the
west, or Europe; and chiefly the middle parts of it, the vast Roman
empire. A mountain here seems to signify a great force and multitude of
people. <scripRef passage="Jer. li. 25" id="i.xxviii.ix-p8.1" parsed="|Jer|51|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.51.25">Jer. li, 25</scripRef>; so this may point at the irruption of the barbarous nations
into the Roman empire. The warlike Goths broke in upon it about the year
2l, and from that time the irruption of one nation after another never
ceased till the very form of the Roman empire, and all but the name, was
lost. The fire may mean the fire of war, and the rage of those savage
nations. And the third part of the sea became blood - This need not
imply, that just a third part of the Roman was slain; but it is certain
an inconceivable deal of blood was shed in all these invasions.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p9">9. And the third part of the creatures that were in the sea
- That is, of all sorts of men, of every station and degree. Died - By
those merciless invaders. And the third part of the ships were destroyed
- It is a frequent thing to resemble a state or republic to a ship,
wherein many people are embarked together, and share in the same
dangers. And how many states were utterly destroyed by those inhuman
conquerors! Much likewise of this was literally fulfilled. How often was
the sea tinged with blood! How many of those who dwelt mostly upon it
were killed! And what number of ships destroyed!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p10">10. And the third angel sounded, and there fell from heaven
a great star, and it fell on the third part of the rivers - It seems
Africa is meant by the rivers; (with which this burning part of the world
abounds in an especial manner;) Egypt in particular, which the Nile
overflows every year far and wide. ln the whole African history, between
the irruption of the barbarous nations into the Roman empire, and the
ruin of the western empire, after the death of Valentinian the Third,
there is nothing more momentous than the Arian calamity, which sprung up
in the year 315. It is not possible to tell how many persons,
particularly at Alexandria, in all Egypt, and in the neighbouring
countries, were destroyed by the rage of the Arians. Yet Africa fared
better than other parts of the empire, with regard to the barbarous
nations, till the governor of it, whose wife was a zealous Arian, and
aunt to Genseric, king of the Vandals, was, under that pretense,
unjustly accused before the empress Placidia. He was then prevailed upon
to invite the Vandals into Afric; who under Genseric, in the year 428,
founded there a kingdom of their own, which continued till the year 533.
Under these Vandal kings the true believers endured all manner of
afflictions and persecutions. And thus Arianism was the inlet to all
heresies and calamities, and at length to Mahometanism itself. This
great star was not an angel, (angels are not the agents in the two
preceding or the following trumpet,) but a teacher of the church, one of
the stars in the right hand of Christ. Such was Arius. He fell from on
high, as it were from heaven, into the most pernicious doctrines, and
made in his fall a gazing on all sides, being great, and now burning as
a torch. He fell on the third part of the rivers - His doctrine spread
far and wide, particularly in Egypt. And on the fountains of water -
wherewith Afric abounds.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p11">11. And the name of the star is called Wormwood - The
unparalleled bitterness both of Arius himself and of his followers show
the exact propriety of his title. And the third part of the waters
became wormwood - A very considerable part of Afric was infected with
the same bitter doctrine and Spirit. And many men (though not a third
part of them) died - By the cruelty of the Arians.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p12">12. And the fourth angel sounded, and the third part of the
sun was smitten - Or struck. After the emperor Theodosius died, and the
empire was divided into the eastern and the western, the barbarous
nations poured in as a flood. The Goths and Hunns in the years 403 and
405 fell upon Italy itself with an impetuous force; and the former, in
the year 410, took Rome by storm, and plundered it without mercy. In the
year 452 Attila treated the upper part of Italy in the same manner. In
455 Valentinian the Third was killed, and Genseric invited from Afric.
He plundered Rome for fourteen days together. Recimer plundered it again
in 472. During all these commotions, one province was lost after
another, till, in the year 476, Odoacer seized upon Rome, deposed the
emperor, and put an end to the empire itself. An eclipse of the sun or
moon is termed by the Hebrews, a stroke. Now, as such a darkness does
not come all at once, but by degrees, so likewise did the darkness which
fell on the Roman, particularly the western empire; for the stroke began
long before Odoacer, namely, when the barbarians first conquered the
capital city. And the third part of the moon, and the third part of the
stars; so that the third part of them was darkened - As under the first,
second, and third trumpets by "the earth," "sea, " and "rivers," are to
be understood the men that inhabit them; so here by the sun, moon, and
stars, may be understood the men that live under them, who are so
overwhelmed with calamities in those days of darkness, that they can no
longer enjoy the light of heaven: unless it may be thought to imply
their being killed; so that the sun, moon, and stars shine to them no
longer. The very same expression we find in <scripRef passage="Ezek. xxxii. 8" id="i.xxviii.ix-p12.1" parsed="|Ezek|32|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.32.8">Ezek. xxxii, 8</scripRef>. "I will darken all the lights of heaven over them." As then
the fourth seal transcends the three preceding seals, so does the fourth
trumpet the three preceding trumpets. For in this not the third part of
the earth, or sea, or rivers only, but of all who are under the sun, are
affected. And the day shone not for a third part thereof - That is,
shone with only a third part of its usual brightness. And the night
likewise - The moon and stars having lost a third part of their lustre,
either with regard to those who, being dead, saw them no longer, or
those who saw them with no satisfaction. The three last trumpets have
the time of their continuance fixed, and between each of them there is a
remarkable pause: whereas between the four former there is no pause, nor
is the time of their continuance mentioned; but all together these four
seem to take up a little less than four hundred years.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.ix-p13">13. And I saw, and heard an angel flying - Between the
trumpets of the fourth and fifth angel. In the midst of heaven - The
three woes, as we shall see, stretch themselves over the earth from
Persia eastward, beyond Italy, westward; all which space had been filled
with the gospel by the apostles. In the midst of this lies Patmos, where
St. John saw this angel, saying, Woe, woe, woe - Toward the end of the
fifth century, there were many presages of approaching calamities. To
the inhabitants of the earth - All without exception. Heavy trials were
coming on them all. Even while the angel was proclaiming this, the
preludes of these three woes were already in motion. These fell more
especially on the Jews. As to the prelude of the first woe in Persia,
Isdegard II., in 454, was resolved to abolish the sabbath, till he was,
by Rabbi Mar, diverted from his purpose. Likewise in the year 474,
Phiruz afflicted the Jews much, and compelled many of them to
apostatize. A prelude of the second woe was the rise of the Saracens,
who, in 510, fell into Arabia and Palestine. To prepare for the third
woe, Innocent I., and his successors, not only endeavoured to enlarge
their episcopal jurisdiction beyond all bounds, but also their worldly
power, by taking every opportunity of encroaching upon the empire, which
as yet stood in the way of their unlimited monarchy.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="27.97%" prev="i.xxviii.ix" next="i.xxviii.xi" id="i.xxviii.x">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.x-p0.1">IX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. IX" id="i.xxviii.x-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.9" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p1">1. And the fifth angel sounded, and I saw a star - Far
different from that mentioned, chap. viii, 11. This star belongs to the
invisible world. The third woe is occasioned by the dragon cast out of
heaven; the second takes place at the loosing of the four angels who
were bound in the Euphrates. The first is here brought by the angel of
the abyss, which is opened by this star, or holy angel. Falling to the
earth - Coming swiftly and with great force. And to him was given - when
he was come. The key of the bottomless pit - A deep and hideous prison;
but different from "the lake of fire."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p2">2. And there arose a smoke out of the pit - The locusts,
who afterwards rise out of it, seem to be, as we shall afterwards see,
the Persians; agreeable to which, this smoke is their detestable
idolatrous doctrine, and false zeal for it, which now broke out in an
uncommon paroxysm. As the smoke of a great furnace - where the clouds of
it rise thicker and thicker, spread far and wide, and press one upon
another, so that the darkness increases continually. And the sun and the
air were darkened - A figurative expression, denoting heavy affliction.
This smoke occasioned more and more such darkness over the Jews in
Persia.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p3">3. And out of the smoke - Not out of the bottomless pit,
but from the smoke which issued thence. There went forth locusts - A
known emblem of a numerous, hostile, hurtful people. Such were the
Persians, from whom the Jews, in the sixth century, suffered beyond
expression. In the year 540 their academies were stopped, nor were they
permitted to have a president for near fifty years. In 589 this
affliction ended; but it began long before 540. The prelude of it was
about the year 455 and 47iv, the main storm came on in the reign of
Cabades, and lasted from 483 to 532. Toward the beginning of the sixth
century, Mar Rab Isaac, president of the academy, was put to death.
Hereon followed an insurrection of the Jews, which lasted seven years
before they were conquered by the Persians. Some of them were then put
to death, but not many; the rest were closely imprisoned. And from this
time the nation of the Jews were hated and persecuted by the Persians,
till they had well nigh rooted them out. The scorpions of the earth -
The most hurtful kind. The scorpions of the air have wings.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p4">4. And it was commanded them - By the secret power of God.
Not to hurt the grass, neither any green thing, nor any tree - Neither
those of low, middling, or high degree, but only such of them as were
not sealed - Principally the unbelieving Israelites. But many who were
called Christians suffered with them.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p5">5. Not to kill them - Very few of them were killed: in
general, they were imprisoned and variously tormented.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p6">6. The men - That is, the men who are so tormented.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p7">7. And the appearances - This description suits a people
neither throughly civilized, nor entirely savage; and such were the
Persians of that age. Of the locusts are like horses - With their
riders. The Persians excelled in horsemanship. And on their heads are as
it were crowns - Turbans. And their faces are as the faces of men -
Friendly and agreeable.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p8">8. And they had hair as the hair of women - All the
Persians of old gloried in long hair. And their teeth were as the teeth
of lions - Breaking and tearing all things in pieces.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p9">9. And the noise of their wings was as the noise of
chariots of many horses - With their war-chariots, drawn by many horses,
they, as it were, flew to and fro.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p10">10. And they have tails like scorpions - That is, each tail
is like a scorpion, not like the tail of a scorpion. To hurt the
unsealed men five months - Five prophetic months; that is, seventy-nine
common years So long did these calamities last.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p11">11. And they have over them a king - One by whom they are
peculiarly directed and governed. His name is Abaddon - Both this and
Apollyon signify a destroyer. By this he is distinguished from the
dragon, whose proper name is Satan.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p12">12. One woe is past; behold, there come yet two woes after
these things - The Persian power, under which was the first woe, was now
broken by the Saracens: from this time the first pause made a wide way
for the two succeeding woes. In 589, when the first woe ended, Mahomet
was twenty years old, and the contentions of the Christians with each
other were exceeding great. In 591 Chosroes II. reigned in Persia, who,
after the death of the emperor, made dreadful disturbances in the east,
Hence Mahomet found an open door for his new religion and empire. And
when the usurper Phocas had, in the year 606, not only declared the
Bishop of Rome, Boniface III., universal bishop, but also the church of
Rome the head of all churches, this was a sure step to advance the
Papacy to its utmost height. Thus, after the passing away of the first
woe, the second, yea, and the third, quickly followed; as indeed they
were both on the way together with it before the first effectually
began.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p13">13. And the sixth angel sounded - Under this angel goes
forth the second woe. And I heard a voice from the four corners of the
golden altar - This golden altar is the heavenly pattern of the
Levitical altar of incense. This voice signified that the execution of
the wrath of God, mentioned verses 20, 21, ver. 20, 21 should, at no
intercession, be delayed any longer.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p14">14. Loose the four angels - To go every way; to the four
quarters. These were evil angels, or they would not have been bound.
Why, or how long, they were bound we know not.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p15">15. And the four angels were loosed, who were prepared - By
loosing them, as well as by their strength and rage. To kill the third
part of men - That is, an immense number of them. For the hour, and day,
and month, and year - All this agrees with the slaughter which the
Saracens made for a long time after Mahomet's death. And with the number
of angels let loose agrees the number of their first and most eminent
caliphs. These were Ali, Abubeker, Omar, and Osman. Mahomet named Ali,
his cousin and son-in-law, for his successor; but he was soon worked out
by the rest, till they severally died, and so made room for him. They
succeeded each other, and each destroyed innumerable multitudes of men.
There are in a prophetic Com. Years. Com. Days. Hour 8 \ Day 196 \ in
all 212 years. Month 15 318 / Year 196 117 / Now, the second woe, as
also the beginning of the third, has its place between the ceasing of
the locusts and the rising of the beast out of the sea, even at the time
that the Saracens, who were chiefly cavalry, were in the height of their
carnage; from their, first caliph, Abubeker, till they were repulsed
from Rome under Leo IV. These 212 years may therefore be reckoned from
the year 634 to 847. The gradation in reckoning the time, beginning with
the hour and ending with a year, corresponds with their small beginning
and vast increase. Before and after Mahomet's death, they had enough to
do to settle their affairs at home. Afterwards Abubeker went farther,
and in the year 634 gained great advantage over the Persians and Rom. in
Syria. Under Omar was the conquest of Mesopotamia, Palestine, and Egypt
made. Under Osman, that of Afric, (with the total suppression of the
Roman government in the year 647,) of Cyprus, and of all Persia in 651.
After Ali was dead, his son Ali Hasen, a peaceable prince, was driven
out by Muavia; under whom, and his successors, the power of the Saracens
so increased, that within fourscore years after Mahomet's death they had
extended their conquests farther than the warlike Roman did in four
hundred years.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p16">16. And the number of the horsemen was two hundred millions
- Not that so many were ever brought into the field at once, but (if we
understand the expression literally) in the course of "the hour, and
day, and month, and year." So neither were "the third part of men
killed" at once, but during that course of years.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p17">17. And thus I saw the horses and them that sat on them in
the vision - St. John seems to add these words, in the vision, to
intimate that we are not to take this description just according to the
letter. Having breastplates of fire - Fiery red. And hyacinth - Dun
blue. And brimstone - A faint yellow. Of the same colour with the fire
and smoke and brimstone, which go out of the mouths of their horses. And
the heads of their horses are as the heads of lions - That is, fierce
and terrible. And out of their mouth goeth fire and smoke and brimstone
- This figurative expression may denote the consuming, blinding,
all-piercing rage, fierceness, and force of these horsemen.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p18">18. By these three - Which were inseparably joined. Were
the third part of men - In the countries they over-ran. Killed - Omar
alone, in eleven years and a half, took thirty-six thousand cities or
forts. How many men must be killed therein!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p19">19. For the power of these horses is in their mouths, and
in their tails - Their riders fight retreating as well as advancing: so
that their rear is as terrible as their front. For their tails are like
serpents, having heads - Not like the tails of serpents only. They may
be fitly compared to the amphisbena, a kind of serpent, which has a
short tail, not unlike a head from which it throws out its poison as if
it had two heads.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p20">20. And the rest of the men who were not killed - Whom the
Saracens did not destroy. It is observable, the countries they over- ran
were mostly those where the gospel had been planted. By these plagues -
Here the description of the second woe ends. Yet repented not - Though
they were called Christians. Of the works of their hands - Presently
specified. That they should not worship devils - The invocation of
departed saints, whether true, or false, or doubtful, or forged, crept
early into the Christian church, and was carried farther and farther;
and who knows how many who are invoked as saints are among evil, not
good, angels; or how far devils have mingled with such blind worship,
and with the wonders wrought on those occasions? And idols - About the
year 590, men began to venerate images; and though upright men zealously
opposed it, yet, by little and little, images grew into manifest idols.
For after much contention, both in the east and west, in the year 787,
the worship of images was established by the second Council of Nice. Yet
was image worship sharply opposed some time after, by the emperor
Theophilus. But when he died, in 842, his widow, Theodoura, established
it again; as did the Council at Constantinople in the year 863, and
again in 871.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.x-p21">21. Neither repented of their murders, nor of their
sorceries - Whoever reads the histories of the seventh, eighth, and
ninth centuries, will find numberless instances of all these in every
part of the Christian world. But though God cut off so many of these
scandals to the Christian name, yet the rest went on in the same course.
Some of them, however, might repent under the plagues which follow.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="28.16%" prev="i.xxviii.x" next="i.xxviii.xii" id="i.xxviii.xi">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xi-p0.1">X</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. X" id="i.xxviii.xi-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.10" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p1">From the first verse of this chapter to chap. xi. 13,
preparation is made for the important trumpet of the seventh angel. It
consists of two parts, which run parallel to each other: the former
reaches from the first to the seventh verse of this chapter; the latter,
from the eighth of this to the thirteenth verse of the eleventh chapter:
whence, also, the sixth verse of this chapter is parallel to the
eleventh verse. The period to which both these refer begins during the
second woe, as appears, chap. xi. 14; but, being once begun, it extends
in a continued course far into the trumpet of the seventh angel. Hence
many things are represented here which are not fulfilled till long
after. So the joyful "consummation of the mystery of God" is spoken of
in the seventh verse of this chapter, which yet is not till after "the
consummation of the wrath of God," chap. xv, 1. So the ascent of the
beast "out of the bottomless pit" is mentioned, chap. xi, 7, which
nevertheless is still to come, chap. xvii, 8; and so "the earthquake,"
by which a tenth part of the great city falls, and the rest are
converted, chap. xi, 13, is really later than that by which the same
city is "split into three parts," chap. xvi, 19. This is a most
necessary observation, whereby we may escape many and great
mistakes.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p2">1. And I saw another mighty angel - Another from that
"mighty angel," mentioned, chap. v, 2; yet he was a created angel; for
he did not swear by himself, verse 6. Clothed with a cloud - In token of
his high dignity. And a rainbow upon his head - A lovely token of the
divine favour. And yet it is not too glorious for a creature: the woman,
chap. xii, 1, is described more glorious still. And his face as the sun
- Nor is this too much for a creature: for all the righteous "shall
shine forth as the sun," <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 43" id="i.xxviii.xi-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|13|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.43">Matt. xiii,
43</scripRef>. And his feet as pillars of fire - Bright as flame.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p3">2. And he had in his hand - His left hand: he swore with
his right. He stood with his right foot on the sea, toward the west; his
left, on the land, toward the east: so that he looked southward. And so
St. John (as Patmos lies near Asia) could conveniently take the book out
of his left hand. This sealed book was first in the right hand of him
that sat on the throne: thence the Lamb took it, and opened the seals.
And now this little book, containing the remainder of the other, is
given opened, as it was, to St. John. From this place the Revelation
speaks more clearly and less figuratively than before. And he set his
right foot upon the sea - Out of which the first beast was to come. And
his left foot upon the earth - Out of which was to come the second. The
sea may betoken Europe; the earth, Asia; the chief theatres of these
great things.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p4">3. And he cried - Uttering the words set down, verse 6. And
while he cried, or was crying - At the same instant. Seven thunders
uttered their voices - In distinct words, each after the other. Those
who spoke these words were glorious, heavenly powers, whose voice was as
the loudest thunder.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p5">4. And I heard a voice from heaven - Doubtless from him who
had at first commanded him to write, and who presently commands him to
take the book; namely, Jesus Christ. Seal up those things which the
seven thunders have uttered, and write them not - These are the only
things of all which he heard that he is commanded to keep secret: so
something peculiarly secret was revealed to the beloved John, besides
all the secrets that are written in this book. At the same time we are
prevented from inquiring what it was which these thunders uttered:
suffice that we may know all the contents of the opened book, and of the
oath of the angel.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p6">5. And the angel - This manifestation of things to come
under the trumpet of the seventh angel hath a twofold introduction:
first, the angel speaks for God, verse 7; then Christ speaks for
himself, chap. xi, 3. The angel appeals to the prophets of former times;
Christ, to his own two witnesses. Whom I saw standing upon the earth and
upon the sea, lifted up his right hand toward heaven - As yet the dragon
was in heaven. When he is cast thence he brings the third and most
dreadful woe on the earth and sea: so that it seems as if there would be
no end of calamities. Therefore the angel comprises, in his posture and
in his oath, both heaven, sea, and earth, and makes on the part of the
eternal God and almighty Creator, a solemn protestation, that he will
assert his kingly authority against all his enemies. He lifted up his
right hand toward heaven - The angel in Daniel, <scripRef passage="Dan. xii. 7" id="i.xxviii.xi-p6.1" parsed="|Dan|12|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.12.7">Dan. xii, 7</scripRef>, (not improbably the same angel,) lifted up both his
hands.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p7">6. And swear - The six preceding trumpets pass without any
such solemnity. It is the trumpet of the seventh angel alone which is
confirmed by so high an oath. By him that liveth forever and ever -
Before whom a thousand years are but a day. Who created the heaven, the
earth, the sea, and the things that are therein - And, consequently, has
the sovereign power over all: therefore, all his enemies, though they
rage a while in heaven, on the sea, and on the earth, yet must give
place to him. That there shall be no more a time - "But in the days of
the voice of the seventh angel, the mystery of God shall be fulfilled:"
that is, a time, a chronos, shall not expire before that mystery is
fulfilled. A chronos (1111 years) will nearly pass before then, but not
quite. The period, then, which we may term a non-chronos (not a whole
time) must be a little, and not much, shorter than this. The non-chronos
here mentioned seems to begin in the year 800, (when Charles the Great
instituted in the west a new line of emperors, or of "many kings,") to
end in the year 1836; and to contain, among other things, the "short
time" of the third woe, the "three times and a half" of the woman in the
wilderness, and the "duration" of the beast.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p8">7. But in the days of the voice of the seventh angel - Who
sounded not only at the beginning of those days, but from the beginning
to the end. The mystery of God shall be fulfilled - It is said, chap.
xvii, 17, "The word of God shall be fulfilled." The word of God is
fulfilled by the destruction of the beast; the mystery, by the removal
of the dragon. But these great events are so near together, that they
are here mentioned as one. The beginning of them is in heaven, as soon
as the seventh trumpet sounds; the end is on the earth and the sea. So
long as the third woe remains on the earth and the sea, the mystery of
God is not fulfilled. And the angel's swearing is peculiarly for the
comfort of holy men, who are afflicted under that woe. Indeed the wrath
of God must be first fulfilled, by the pouring out of the phials: and
then comes the joyful fulfilling of the mystery of God. As he hath
declared to his servants the prophets - The accomplishment exactly
answering the prediction. The ancient prophecies relate partly to that
grand period, from the birth of Christ to the destruction of Jerusalem;
partly to the time of the seventh angel, wherein they will be fully
accomplished. To the seventh trumpet belongs all that occurs from chap.
xi, 15 - chap. xxii, 5. And the third woe, which takes place under the
same, properly stands, chap. xii, 12, xiii, 1-18.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p9">8. And - what follows from this verse to chap. xi, 13, runs
parallel with the oath of the angel, and with "the fulfilling of the
mystery of God," as it follows under the trumpet of the seventh angel;
what is said, verse 11, concerning St. John's "prophesying again," is
unfolded immediately after; what is said, verse 7, concerning "the
fulfilling the mystery of God," is unfolded, chap. xi, 15-19 and in the
following chapters.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p10">9. Eat it up - The like was commanded to Ezekiel. This was
an emblem of thoroughly considering and digesting it. And it will make
thy belly bitter, but it will be sweet as honey in thy mouth - The
sweetness betokens the many good things which follow, chap. xi, 1, 15,
&amp;c.; the bitterness, the evils which succeed under the third
woe.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xi-p11">11. Thou must prophesy again - Of the mystery of God; of
which the ancient prophets had prophesied before. And he did prophesy,
by "measuring the temple," chap. xi, 1; as a prophecy may be delivered
either by words or actions. Concerning people, and nations, and tongues,
and many kings - The people, nations, and tongues are contemporary; but
the kings, being many, succeed one another. These kings are not
mentioned for their own sake, but with a view to the "holy city," chap.
xi, 2. Here is a reference to the great kingdoms in Spain, England,
Italy, &amp;c., which arose from the eighth century; or at least
underwent a considerable change, as France and Germany in particular; to
the Christian, afterward Turkish, empire in the east; and especially to
the various potentates, who have successively reigned at or over
Jerusalem, and do now, at least titularly, reign over it.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="28.32%" prev="i.xxviii.xi" next="i.xxviii.xiii" id="i.xxviii.xii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xii-p0.1">XI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XI" id="i.xxviii.xii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.11" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p1">In this chapter is shown how it will fare with "the holy
city," till the mystery of God is fulfilled; in the twelfth, what will
befall the woman, who is delivered of the man-child; in the thirteenth,
how it will be with the kingdom of Christ, while the "two beasts" are in
the height of their power. And there was given me - By Christ, as
appears from the third verse. And he said, Arise - Probably he was
sitting to write. And measure the temple of God - At Jerusalem, where he
was placed in the vision. Of this we have a large description by
Ezekiel, Ezek. xl - xlviii; concerning which we may observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p2">1. Ezekiel's prophecy was not fulfilled at
the return from the Babylonish captivity.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p3">2. Yet it does not refer to the "New
Jerusalem," which is far more gloriously described.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p4">3. It must infallibly be fulfilled even then
"when they are ashamed of all that they have done," <scripRef passage="Ezek. xliii. 11" id="i.xxviii.xii-p4.1" parsed="|Ezek|43|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.43.11">Ezek. xliii, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p5">4. Ezekiel speaks of the same temple which is
treated of here.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p6">5. As all things are there so largely
described, St. John is shorter and refers thereto.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p7">2. But the court which is without the temple - The old
temple had a court in the open air, for the heathens who worshipped the
God of Israel. Cast out - Of thy account. And measure it not - As not
being holy In so high a degree. And they shall tread - Inhabit. The holy
city - Jerusalem, <scripRef passage="Matt. iv. 5" id="i.xxviii.xii-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|4|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4.5">Matt. iv,
5</scripRef>. So they began to do, before St. John wrote. And it has been
trodden almost ever since by the Romans, Persians, Saracens, and Turks.
But that severe kind of treading which is here peculiarly spoken of,
will not be till under the trumpet of the seventh angel, and toward the
end of the troublous times. This will continue but forty-two common
months, or twelve hundred and sixty common days; being but a small part
of the non-chronos.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p8">3. And I - Christ. Will give to my two witnesses - These
seem to be two prophets; two select, eminent instruments. Some have
supposed (though without foundation) that they are Moses and Elijah,
whom they resemble in several respects. To prophesy twelve hundred and
sixty days - Common days, that is, an hundred and eighty weeks. So long
will they prophesy, (even while that last and sharp treading of the holy
city continues,) both by word and deed, witnessing that Jesus is the Son
of God, the heir of all things, and exhorting all men to repent, and
fear, and glorify God. Clothed in sackcloth - The habit of the deepest
mourners, out of sorrow and concern for the people.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p9">4. These are the two olive trees - That is, as Zerubbabel
and Joshua, the two olive trees spoken of by Zechariah, <scripRef passage="Zech. iii. 9" id="i.xxviii.xii-p9.1" parsed="|Zech|3|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.3.9">Zech. iii, 9</scripRef>, iv, 10, were then the two chosen instruments in God's hand,
even so shall these. be in their season. Being themselves full of the
unction of the Holy One, they shall continually transmit the same to
others also. And the two candlesticks - Burning and shining lights.
Standing before the Lord of the earth - Always waiting on God, without
the help of man, and asserting his right over the earth and all things
therein.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p10">5. If any would kill them - As the Israelites would have
done Moses and Aaron, <scripRef passage="Num. xvi. 41" id="i.xxviii.xii-p10.1" parsed="|Num|16|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.16.41">Num. xvi,
41</scripRef>. He must be killed thus - By that devouring fire.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p11">6. These have power - And they use that power. See verse
10. To shut heaven, that it rain not in the days of their prophesying -
During those "twelve hundred and sixty days." And have power over the
waters - In and near Jerusalem. To turn them into blood - As Moses did
those in Egypt. And to smite the earth with all plagues, as often as
they will - This is not said of Moses or Elijah, or any mere man
besides. And how is it possible to understand this otherwise than of two
individual persons?</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p12">7. And when they shall have finished their testimony - Till
then they are invincible. The wild beast - Hereafter to be described.
That ascendeth - First out of the sea, chap. xiii, 1, and then out of
the bottomless pit, chap. xvii, 8. Shall make war with them - It is at
his last ascent, not out of the sea, but the bottomless pit, that the
beast makes war upon the two witnesses. And even hereby is fixed the
time of "treading the holy city," and of the "two witnesses." That time
ends after the ascent of the beast out of the abyss, and yet before the
fulfilling of the mystery. And shall conquer them - The fire no longer
proceeding out of their mouth when they have finished their work. And
kill them - These will be among the last martyrs, though not the last of
all.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p13">8. And their bodies shall be - Perhaps hanging on a cross.
In the street of the great city - Of Jerusalem, a far greater city, than
any other in those parts. This is described both spiritually and
historically: spiritually, as it is called Sodom Isaiah i, and Egypt; on
account of the same abominations abounding there, at the time of the
witnesses, as did once in Egypt and Sodom. Historically: Where also
their Lord was crucified - This possibly refers to the very ground where
his cross stood. Constantine the Great inclosed this within the walls of
the city. Perhaps on that very spot will their bodies be exposed.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p14">9. Three days and a half - So exactly are the times set
down in this prophecy. If we suppose this time began in the evening, and
ended in the morning, and included (which is no way impossible) Friday,
Saturday, and Sunday, the weekly festival of the Turkish people, the
Jewish tribes, and the Christian tongues; then all these together, with
the heathen nations, would have full leisure to gaze upon and rejoice
over them.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p15">10. And they that dwell upon the earth - Perhaps this
expression may peculiarly denote earthly-minded men. Shall make merry -
As did the Philistines over Samson. And send gifts to one another - Both
Turks, and Jews, and heathens, and false Christians.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p16">11. And great fear fell upon them that saw them - And now
knew that God was on their side.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p17">12. And I heard a great voice - Designed for all to hear.
And they went up to heaven, and their enemies beheld them - who had not
taken notice of their rising again; by which some had been convinced
before.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p18">13. And there was a great earthquake and the tenth part of
the city fell - We have here an unanswerable proof that this city is not
Babylon or Rome, but Jerusalem. For Babylon shall be wholly burned
before the fulfilling of the mystery of God. But this city is not burned
at all; on the contrary, at the fulfilling of that mystery, a tenth part
of it is destroyed by an earthquake, and the other nine parts converted.
And there were slain in the earthquake seven thousand men - Being a
tenth part of the inhabitants, who therefore were seventy thousand in
all. And the rest - The remaining sixty-three thousand were converted: a
grand step toward the fulfilling of the mystery of God. Such a
conversion we no where else read of. So there shall be a larger as well
as holier church at Jerusalem than ever was yet. Were terrified -
Blessed terror! And gave glory - The character of true conversion, <scripRef passage="Jer. xiii. 16" id="i.xxviii.xii-p18.1" parsed="|Jer|13|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.13.16">Jer. xiii, 16</scripRef>. To the God of heaven - He is styled, "The Lord of the
earth," verse 4, when he declares his right over the earth by the two
witnesses; but the God of heaven, when he not only gives rain from
heaven after the most afflicting drought, but also declares his majesty
from heaven, by taking his witnesses up into it. When the whole
multitude gives glory to the God of heaven, then that "treading of the
holy city" ceases. This is the point so long aimed at, the desired
"fulfilling of the mystery of God," when the divine promises are so
richly fulfilled on those who have gone through so great afflictions.
All this is here related together, that whereas the first and second woe
went forth in the east, the rest of the eastern affairs being added at
once, the description of the western might afterwards remain unbroken.
It may be useful here to see how the things here spoken of, and those
hereafter described, follow each other in their order.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p19">1. The angel swears; the non-chronos begins;
John eats the book; the many kings arise.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p20">2. The non-chronos and the "many kings" being
on the decline, that treading" begins, and the "two witnesses"
appear.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p21">3. The beast, after he has with the ten kings
destroyed Babylon, wars with them and kills them. After three days and
an half they revive and ascend to heaven. There is a great earthquake in
the holy city: seven thousand perish, and the rest are converted. The
"treading" of the city by the gentiles ends.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p22">4. The beast, and the kings of the earth, and
their armies are assembled to fight against the Great King.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p23">5. Multitudes of his enemies are killed, and
the beast and the false prophet cast alive into the lake of fire.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p24">6. while John measures the temple of God and
the altar with the worshippers, the true worship of God is set up. The
nations who had trodden the holy city are converted. Hereby the mystery
of God is fulfilled.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p25">7. Satan is imprisoned. Being released for a
time, he, with Gog and Magog, makes his last assault upon Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p26">14. The second woe is past - The butchery made by the
Saracens ceased about the year 847, when their power was so broken by
Charles the Great that they never recovered it. Behold, the third woe
cometh quickly - Its prelude came while the Roman see took all
opportunities of laying claim to its beloved universality, and enlarging
its power and grandeur. And in the year 755 the bishop of Rome became a
secular prince, by king Pepin's giving him the exarchate of Lombardy.
The beginning of the third woe itself stands, chap. xii, 12.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p27">15. And the seventh angel sounded - This trumpet contains
the most important and joyful events, and renders all the former
trumpets matter of joy to all the inhabitants of heaven. The allusion
therefore in this and all the trumpets is to those used in festal
solemnities. All these seven trumpets were heard in heaven: perhaps the
seventh shall once be heard on earth also, <scripRef passage="1 Thess. iv. 16" id="i.xxviii.xii-p27.1" parsed="|1Thess|4|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Thess.4.16">1 Thess. iv, 16</scripRef>. And there were great voices - From the several citizens of
heaven. At the opening of the seventh seal "there was silence in
heaven;" at the sounding of the seventh trumpet, great voices. This
alone is sufficient to show that the seven seals and seven trumpets do
not run parallel to each other. As soon as the seventh angel sounds, the
kingdom falls to God and his Christ. This immediately appears in heaven,
and is there celebrated with joyful praise. But on earth several
dreadful occurrences are to appear first. This trumpet comprises all
that follows from these voices to chap. xxii, 5. The kingdom of the
world - That is, the royal government over the whole world, and all its
kingdoms, <scripRef passage="Zech. xiv. 9" id="i.xxviii.xii-p27.2" parsed="|Zech|14|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.14.9">Zech. xiv, 9</scripRef>. Is become the kingdom of the Lord - This province has been
in the enemy's hands: it now returns to its rightful Master. In the Old
Testament, from Moses to Samuel, God himself was the King of his own
people. And the same will be in the New Testament: he will himself reign
over the Israel of God. And of his Christ - This appellation is now
first given him, since the introduction of the book, on the mention of
the kingdom devolving upon him, under the seventh trumpet. Prophets and
priests were anointed, but more especially kings: whence that term, the
anointed, is applied only to a king. Accordingly, whenever the Messiah
is mentioned in scripture, his kingdom is implied. Is become - In
reality, all things (and so the kingdom of the world) are God's in all
ages: yet Satan and the present world, with its kings and lords, are
risen against the Lord and against his Anointed. God now puts an end to
this monstrous rebellion, and maintains his right to all things. And
this appears in an entirely new manner, as soon as the seventh angel
sounds.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p28">16. And the four and twenty elders - These shall reign over
the earth, chap. v, 10. Who sit before God on their thrones - which we
do not read of any angel.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p29">17. The Almighty - He who hath all things in his power as
the only Governor of them. Who is, and who was - God is frequently
styled, "He who is, and who was, and who is to come." but now he is
actually come, the words, "who is to come," are, as it were, swallowed
up. When it is said, We thank thee that thou hast taken thy great power,
it is all one as, "We thank thee that thou art come." This whole
thanksgiving is partly an enlargement on the two great points mentioned
in the fifteenth verse; partly a summary of what is hereafter more
distinctly related. Here it is mentioned, how the kingdom is the Lord's;
afterwards, how it is the kingdom of his Christ. Thou hast taken thy
great power - This is the beginning of what is done under the trumpet of
the seventh angel. God has never ceased to use his power; but he has
suffered his enemies to oppose it, which he will now suffer no more.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p30">18. And the heathen nations were wroth - At the breaking
out of the power and kingdom of God. This wrath of the heathens now
rises to the highest pitch; but it meets the wrath of the Almighty, and
melts away. In this verse is described both the going forth and the end
of God's wrath, which together take up several ages. And the time of the
dead is come - Both of the quick and dead, of whom those already dead
are far the more numerous part. That they be judged - This, being
infallibly certain, they speak of as already present. And to give a
reward - At the coming of Christ, chap. xxii, 12; but of free grace, not
of debt,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p31">1. To his servants the prophets:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p32">2. To his saints: to them who were eminently
holy:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xii-p33">3. To them that fear his name: these are the
lowest class. Those who do not even fear God will have no reward from
him. Small and great - All universally, young and old, high and low,
rich and poor. And to destroy them that destroyed the earth - The earth
was destroyed by the "great whore" in particular, chap. xix, 2; xvii, 2,
5; but likewise in general, by the open rage and hate of wicked men
against all that is good; by wars, and the various destruction and
desolation naturally flowing therefrom; by such laws and constitutions
as hinder much good, and occasion many offenses and calamities; by
public scandals, whereby a door is opened for all dissoluteness and
unrighteousness; by abuse of secular and spiritual powers; by evil
doctrines, maxims, and counsels; by open violence and persecution; and
by sins crying to God to send plagues upon the earth. This great work of
God, destroying the destroyers, under the trumpet of the seventh angel,
is not the third woe, but matter of joy, for which the elders solemnly
give thanks. All the woes, and particularly the third, go forth over
those "who dwell upon the earth;" but this destruction, over those "who
destroy the earth," and were also instruments of that woe.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xii-p34">19. And the temple of God-The inmost part of it. Was opened
in heaven - And hereby is opened a new scene of the most momentous
things, that we may see how the contents of the seventh trumpet are
executed; and, notwithstanding the greatest opposition, (particularly by
the third woe,) brought to a glorious conclusion. And the ark of the
covenant was seen in his temple - The ark of the covenant which was made
by Moses was not in the second temple, being probably burnt with the
first temple by the Chaldeans. But here is the heavenly ark of the
everlasting covenant, the shadow of which was under the Old Testament, <scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 4" id="i.xxviii.xii-p34.1" parsed="|Heb|9|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.4">Heb. ix, 4</scripRef>. The inhabitants of heaven saw the ark before: St. John also
saw it now; for a testimony, that what God had promised, should be
fulfilled to the uttermost. And there were lightnings, and voices, and
thunders, and an earthquake, and great hail - The very same there are,
and in the same order, when the seventh angel has poured out his phial;
chap. xvi, 17-xxi, one place answers the other. What the trumpet here
denounces in heaven, is there executed by the phial upon earth. First it
is shown what will be done; and afterwards it is done.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="28.59%" prev="i.xxviii.xii" next="i.xxviii.xiv" id="i.xxviii.xiii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xiii-p0.1">XII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XII" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.12" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p1">The great vision of this book goes straight forward, from
the fourth to the twenty-second chapter. Only the tenth, with part of
the eleventh chapter, was a kind of introduction to the trumpet of the
seventh angel; after which it is said, "The second woe is past: behold,
the third woe cometh quickly." Immediately the seventh angel sounds,
under whom the third woe goes forth. And to this trumpet belongs all
that is related to the end of the book. Verse</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p2">1. And a great sign was seen in heaven - Not only by St.
John, but many heavenly spectators represented in the vision. A sign
means something that has an uncommon appearance, and from which we infer
that some unusual thing will follow. A woman - The emblem of the church
of Christ, as she is originally of Israel, though built and enlarged on
all sides by the addition of heathen converts; and as she will hereafter
appear, when all her "natural branches are again "grafted in." She is at
present on earth; and yet, with regard to her union with Christ, may be
said to be in heaven, <scripRef passage="Eph. ii. 6" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p2.1" parsed="|Eph|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.2.6">Eph. ii,
6</scripRef>. Accordingly, she is described as both assaulted and
defended in heaven, verses 4, 7. chap. xii, 4, 7 Clothed with the sun,
and the moon under her feet, and on her head a crown of twelve stars -
These figurative expressions must he so interpreted as to preserve a due
proportion between them. So, in Joseph's dream, the sun betokened his
father; the moon, his mother; the stars, their children. There may be
some such resemblance here; and as the prophecy points out the "power
over all nations," perhaps the sun may betoken the Christian world; the
moon, the Mahometans, who also carry the moon in their ensigns; and the
crown of twelve stars, the twelve tribes of Israel; which are smaller
than the sun and moon. The whole of this chapter answers the state of
the church from the ninth century to this time.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p3">2. And being with child she crieth, travailing in birth -
The very pain, without any outward opposition, would constrain a woman
in travail to cry out. These cries, throes, and pains to be delivered,
were the painful longings, the sighs, and prayers of the saints for the
coming of the kingdom of God. The woman groaned and travailed in spirit,
that Christ might appear, as the Shepherd and King of all nations.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p4">3. And behold a great red dragon - His fiery-red colour
denoting his disposition. Having seven heads - Implying vast wisdom. And
ten horns - Perhaps on the seventh head; emblems of mighty power and
strength, which he still retained. And seven diadems on his heads - Not
properly crowns, but costly bindings, such as kings anciently wore; for,
though fallen, he was a great potentate still, even "the prince of this
world."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p5">4. And his tail - His falsehood and subtilty. Draweth - As
a train. The third part - A very large number. Of the stars of heaven -
The Christians and their teachers, who before sat in heavenly places
with Christ Jesus. And casteth them to the earth - Utterly deprives them
of all those heavenly blessings. This is properly a part of the
description of the dragon, who was not yet himself on earth, but in
heaven: consequently, this casting them down was between the beginning
of the seventh trumpet and the beginning of the third woe; or between
the year 847 and the year 947; at which time pestilent doctrines,
particularly that of the Manichees in the east, drew abundance of people
from the truth. And the dragon stood before the woman, that when she had
brought forth, he might devour the child - That he might hinder the
kingdom of Christ from spreading abroad, as it does under this
trumpet.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p6">5. And she brought forth a man child - Even Christ,
considered not in his person, but in his kingdom. In the ninth age, many
nations with their princes were added to the Christian church. Who was
to rule all nations - When his time is come. And her child - Which was
already in heaven, as were the woman and the dragon. Was caught up to
God - Taken utterly out of his reach.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p7">6. And the woman fled into the wilderness - This wilderness
is undoubtedly on earth, where the woman also herself is now supposed to
be. It betokens that part of the earth where, after having brought
forth, she found a new abode. And this must be in Europe; as Asia and
Afric were wholly in the hands of the Turks and Saracens; and in a part
of it where the woman had not been before. In this wilderness, God had
already prepared a place; that is, made it safe and convenient for her.
The wilderness is, those countries of Europe which lie on this side the
Danube; for the countries which lie beyond it had received Christianity
before. That they may feed her - That the people of that place may
provide all things needful for her. Twelve hundred and sixty days - So
many prophetic days, which are not, as some have supposed, twelve
hundred and sixty, but seven hundred and seventy-seven, common years.
This Bengelius has shown at large in his German Introduction. These we
may compute from the year 847 to 1524. So long the woman enjoyed a safe
and convenient place in Europe, which was chiefly Bohemia; where she was
fed, till God provided for her more plentifully at the Reformation.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p8">7. And there was war in heaven - Here Satan makes his grand
opposition to the kingdom of God; but an end is now put to his accusing
the saints before God. The cause goes against him, verses 10, 11, chap.
xii, 10, 11 and Michael executes the sentence. That Michael is a created
angel, appears from his not daring, in disputing with Satan, <scripRef passage="Jude 9" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p8.1" parsed="|Jude|1|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.1.9">Jude 9</scripRef>, to
bring a railing accusation; but only saying, "The Lord rebuke thee." And
this modesty is implied in his very name; for Michael signifies, "Who is
like God?" which implies also his deep reverence toward God, and
distance from all self-exaltation. Satan would be like God: the very
name of Michael asks, "Who is like God?" Not Satan; not the highest
archangel. It is he likewise that is afterward employed to seize, bind,
and imprison that proud spirit.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p9">8. And he prevailed not - The dragon himself is principally
mentioned; but his angels, likewise, are to be understood. Neither was
this place found any more in heaven - So till now he had a place in
heaven. How deep a mystery is this! One may compare this with <scripRef passage="Luke x. 18" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p9.1" parsed="|Luke|10|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.10.18">Luke x, 18</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Eph. ii. 2; iv. 8; vi. 12" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p9.2" parsed="|Eph|2|2|0|0;|Eph|4|8|0|0;|Eph|6|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.2.2 Bible:Eph.4.8 Bible:Eph.6.12">Eph. ii, 2; iv, 8; vi,
12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p10">9. And the great dragon was cast out - It is not yet said,
unto the earth - He was cast out of heaven; and at this the inhabitants
of heaven rejoice. He is termed the great dragon, as appearing here in
that shape, to intimate his poisonous and cruel disposition. The ancient
serpent - In allusion to his deceiving Eve in that form. Dragons are a
kind of large serpent. Who is called the Devil and Satan - These are
words of exactly the same meaning; only the former is Greek; the latter,
Hebrew; denoting the grand adversary of all the saints, whether Jews or
gentiles. He has deceived the whole world - Not only in their first
parents, but through all ages, and in all countries, into unbelief and
all wickedness; into the hating and persecuting faith and all goodness.
He was cast out unto the earth - He was cast out of heaven; and being
cast out thence, himself came to the earth. Nor had he been unemployed
on the earth before, although his ordinary abode was in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p11">10. Now is come - Hence it is evident that all this chapter
belongs to the trumpet of the seventh angel. In the eleventh chapter,
from the fifteenth to the eighteenth verse, are proposed the contents of
this extensive trumpet; the execution of which is copiously described in
this and the following chapters. The salvation - Of the saints. The
might - Whereby the enemy is cast out. The kingdom - Here the majesty of
God is shown. And the power of his Christ - Which he will exert against
the beast; and when he also is taken away, then will the kingdom be
ascribed to Christ himself, chap. xix, 16; xx, 4. The accuser of our
brethren -- so long as they remained on earth. This great voice,
therefore, was the voice of men only. Who accused them before our God
day and night - Amazing malice of Satan, and patience of God!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p12">11. And they have overcome him - Carried the cause against
him. By the blood of the Lamb - Which cleanses the soul from all sin,
and so leaves no room for accusing. And by the word of their testimony -
The word of God, which they believed and testified, even unto death. So,
for instance, died Olam, king of Sweden, in the year 900, whom his own
subjects would have compelled to idolatry; and, upon his refusal, slew
as a sacrifice to the idol which he would not worship. So did multitudes
of Bohemian Christians, in the year 916, when queen Drahomire raised a
severe persecution, wherein many "loved not their lives unto the
death."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p13">12. Woe to the earth and the sea - This is the fourth and
last denunciation of the third woe, the most grievous of all. The first
was only, the second chiefly, on the earth, Asia; the third, both on the
earth and the sea, Europe. The earth is mentioned first, because it
began in Asia, before the beast brought it on Europe. He knoweth he hath
but a little time - Which extends from his casting out of heaven to his
being cast into the abyss. We are now come to a most important period of
time. The non-chronos hastens to an end. We live in the little time
wherein Satan hath great wrath; and this little time is now upon the
decline. We are in the "time, times, and half a time," wherein the woman
is "fed in the wilderness;" yea, the last part of it, "the half time,"
is begun. We are, as will be shown, towards the close of the "forty-two
months" of the beast; and when his number is fulfilled, grievous things
will be. Let him who does not regard the being seized by the wrath of
the devil; the falling unawares into the general temptation; the being
born away, by the most dreadful violence, into the worship of the beast
and his image, and, consequently, drinking the unmixed wine of the wrath
of God, and being tormented day and night forever and ever in the lake
of fire and brimstone; let him also who is confident that he can make
his way through all these by his own wisdom and strength, without need
of any such peculiar preservative as the word of this prophecy affords;
let him, I say, go hence. But let him who does not take these warnings
for senseless outcries, and blind alarms, beg of God, with all possible
earnestness, to give him his heavenly light herein. God has not given
this prophecy, in so solemn a manner, only to show his providence over
his church, but also that his servants may know at all times in what
particular period they are. And the more dangerous any period of time
is, the greater is the help which it affords. But where may we fix the
beginning and end of the little time? which is probably four-fifths of a
chronos, or somewhat above 888 years. This, which is the time of the
third woe, may reach from 947, to the year 1836. For,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p14">1. The short interval of the second woe,
(which woe ended in the year 840,) and the 777 years of the woman, which
began about the year 847, quickly after which followed the war in
heaven, fix the beginning not long after 8lxiv, and thus the third woe
falls in the tenth century, extending from 900 to 1000; called the dark,
the iron, the unhappy age.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p15">2. If we compare the length of the third woe
with the period of time which succeeds it in the twentieth chapter, it
is but a little time to that vast space which reaches from the beginning
of the non-chronos to the end of the world.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p16">13. And when the dragon saw - That he could no longer
accuse the saints in heaven, he turned his wrath to do all possible
mischief on earth. He persecuted the woman - The ancient persecutions of
the church were mentioned, chap. i, 9, ii, 10, vii, 14; but this
persecution came after her flight, verse 6, just at the beginning of the
third woe. Accordingly, in the tenth and eleventh centuries, the church
was furiously persecuted by several heathen powers. In Prussia, king
Adelbert was killed in the year 997, king Brunus in 1008; and when king
Stephen encouraged Christianity in Hungary, he met with violent
opposition. After his death, the heathens in Hungary set themselves to
root it out, and prevailed for several years. About the same time, the
army of the emperor, Henry the Third, was totally overthrown by the
Vandals. These, and all the accounts of those times, show with what fury
the dragon then persecuted the woman.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p17">14. And there were given to the woman the two wings of the
great eagle, that she might fly into the wilderness to her place -
Eagles are the usual symbols of great potentates. So <scripRef passage="Ezek. xvii. 3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p17.1" parsed="|Ezek|17|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.17.3">Ezek. xvii, 3</scripRef>, by "a great eagle', means the king of Babylon. Here the
great eagle is the Roman empire; the two wings, the eastern and western
branches of it. A place in the wilderness was mentioned in the sixth
verse also; but it is not the same which is mentioned here. In the text
there follow one after the other,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p18">1. The dragon's waiting to devour the
child.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p19">2. The birth of the child, which is caught up
to God.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p20">3. The fleeing of the woman into the
wilderness.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p21">4. The war in heaven, and the casting out of
the dragon.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p22">5. The beginning of the third woe.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p23">6. The persecution raised by the dragon
against the woman.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p24">7. The woman's flying away upon the eagle's
wings. In like manner there follow one after the other,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p25">1. The beginning of the twelve hundred and
sixty days.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p26">2. The beginning of the little time.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p27">3. The beginning of the time, times, and half
a time. This third period partly coincides both with the first and the
second. After the beginning of the twelve hundred and sixty days, or
rather of the third woe, Christianity was exceedingly propagated, in the
midst of various persecutions. About the year 948 it was again settled
in Denmark; in 965, in Poland and Silesia; in 980, through all Russia.
In 997 it was brought into Hungary; into Sweden and Norway, both before
and after. Transylvania received it about 1000; and, soon after, other
parts of Dacia. Now, all the countries in which Christianity was settled
between the beginning of the twelve hundred and sixty days, and the
imprisonment of the dragon, may be understood by the wilderness, and by
her place in particular. This place contained many countries; so that
Christianity now reached, in an uninterrupted tract, from the eastern to
the western empire; and both the emperors now lent their wings to the
woman, and provided a safe abode for her. Where she is fed - By God
rather than man; having little human help. For a time, and times, and
half a time - The length of the several periods here mentioned seems to
be nearly this: - YEARS</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p28">1. The non-chronos contains less than
1111</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p29">2. The little time 888</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p30">3. The time, times, and half a time 777</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p31">4. The time of the beast 666 And comparing
the prophecy and history together, they seem to begin and end nearly
thus:</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p32">1. The non-chronos extends from about 800 to
1836</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p33">2. The 1260 days of the woman from
847-1524</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p34">3. The little time 947-1836</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p35">4. The time, time, and half 1058-1836</p>

<p class="List6" id="i.xxviii.xiii-p36">5. The time of the beast is between the
beginning and end of the three times and a half. In the year 1058 the
empires had a good understanding with each other, and both protected the
woman. The bishops of Rome, likewise, particularly Victor II., were duly
subordinate to the emperor. We may observe, the twelve hundred and sixty
days of the woman, from 847 to 1524, and the three times and a half,
refer to the same wilderness. But in the former part of the twelve
hundred and sixty days, before the three times and an half began,
namely, from the year 847 to 1058, she was fed by others, being little
able to help herself; whereas, from 1058 to 1524, she is both fed by
others, and has food herself. To this the sciences transplanted into the
west from the eastern countries much contributed; the scriptures, in the
original tongues, brought into the west of Europe by the Jews and
Greeks, much more; and most of all, the Reformation, grounded on those
scriptures.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p37">15. Water is an emblem of a great people; this water, of
the Turks in particular. About the year 1060 they overran the Christian
part of Asia. Afterward, they poured into Europe, and spread farther and
farther, till they had overflowed many nations.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p38">16. But the earth helped the woman - The powers of the
earth; and indeed she needed help through this whole period. "The time"
was from 1058 to 1280; during which the Turkish flood ran higher and
higher, though frequently repressed by the emperors, or their generals,
helping the woman. "The" two "times" were from 1280 to 1725. During
these likewise the Turkish power flowed far and wide; but still from
time to time the princes of the earth helped the woman, that she was not
carried away by it. "The half time" is from 1725 to 1836. In the
beginning of this period the Turks began to meddle with the affairs of
Persia: wherein they have so entangled themselves, as to be the less
able to prevail against the two remaining Christian empires. Yet this
flood still reaches the woman "in her place;" and will, till near the
end of the "half time," itself be swallowed up, perhaps by means of
Russia, which is risen in the room of the eastern empire.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiii-p39">17. And the dragon was wroth - Anew, because he could not
cause her to be carried away by the stream. And he went forth - Into
other lands. To make war with the rest of her seed - Real Christians,
living under heathen or Turkish governors.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="28.90%" prev="i.xxviii.xiii" next="i.xxviii.xv" id="i.xxviii.xiv">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xiv-p0.1">XIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XIII" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.13" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p1">1. And I stood on the sand of the sea - This also was in
the vision. And I saw - Soon after the woman flew away. A wild beast
coming up - He comes up twice; first from the sea, then from the abyss.
He comes from the sea before the seven phials; "the great whore" comes
after them. O reader, this is a subject wherein we also are deeply
concerned, and which must be treated, not as a point of curiosity, but
as a solemn warning from God! The danger is near. Be armed both against
force and fraud, even with the whole armour of God. Out of the sea -
That is, Europe. So the three woes (the first being in Persia, the
second about the Euphrates) move in a line from east to west. This beast
is the Romish Papacy, as it came to a point six hundred years since,
stands now, and will for some time longer. To this, and no other power
on earth, agrees the whole text, and every part of it in every point; as
we may see, with the utmost evidence, from the propositions following: -
PROP. 1. It is one and the same beast, having seven heads, and ten
horns, which is described in this and in the seventeenth chapter. Of
consequence, his heads are the same, and his horns also. PROP. 2. This
beast is a spiritually secular power, opposite to the kingdom of Christ.
A power not merely spiritual or ecclesiastical, nor merely secular or
political but a mixture of both. He is a secular prince; for a crown,
yea, and a kingdom are ascribed to him. And yet he is not merely
secular; for he is also a false prophet. PROP. 3. The beast has a strict
connection with the city of Rome. This clearly appears from the
seventeenth chapter. PROP. 4. The beast is now existing. He is not past.
for Rome is now existing; and it is not till after the destruction of
Rome that the beast is thrown into the lake. He is not altogether to
come: for the second woe is long since past, after which the third came
quickly; and presently after it began, the beast rose out of the sea.
Therefore, whatever he is, he is now existing. PROP. 5. The beast is the
Romish Papacy. This manifestly follows from the third and fourth
propositions; the beast has a strict connection with the city of Rome;
and the beast is now existing: therefore, either there is some other
power more strictly connected with that city, or the Pope is the beast.
PROP. 6. The Papacy, or papal kingdom, began long ago. The most
remarkable particulars relating to this are here subjoined; taken so
high as abundantly to show the rise of the beast, and brought down as
low as our own time, in order to throw a light on the following part of
the prophecy: A.D. 1033. Benedict the Ninth, a child of eleven years
old, is bishop of Rome, and occasions grievous disorders for above
twenty years. A.D. 1048. Damasus II. introduces the use of the triple
crown. A.D. 1058. The church of Milan is, after long opposition,
subjected to the Roman. A.D. 1073. Hildebrand, or Gregory VII., comes to
the throne. A.D. 1076. He deposes and excommunicates the emperor. A.D.
1077. He uses him shamefully and absolves him. A.D. 1080. He
excommunicates him again, and sends a crown to Rodulph, his competitor.
A.D. 1083. Rome is taken. Gregory flees. Clement is made Pope, and
crowns the emperor. A.D. 1085. Gregory VII. dies at Salerno. A.D. 1095.
Urban II. holds the first Popish council, at Clermont and gives rise to
the crusades. A.D. 1111. Paschal II. quarrels furiously with the
emperor. A.D. 1123. The first western general council in the Lateran.
The marriage of priests is forbidden. A.D. 1132. Innocent II declares
the emperor to be the Pope's liege-man, or vassal. A.D. 1143. The Roman
set up a governor of their own, independent on Innocent II. He
excommunicates them, and dies. Celestine II. is, by an important
innovation, chosen to the Popedom without the suffrage of the people;
the right of choosing the Pope is taken from the people, and afterward
from the clergy, and lodged in the Cardinals alone. A.D. 1152. Eugene
II. assumes the power of canonizing saints. A.D. 1155. Adrian IV. puts
Arnold of Brixia to death for speaking against the secular power of the
Papacy. A.D. 1159. Victor IV. is elected and crowned. But Alexander III.
conquers him and his successor. A.D. 1168. Alexander III. excommunicates
the emperor, and brings him so low, that, A.D. 1177. he submits to the
Pope's setting his foot on his neck. A.D. 1204. Innocent III. sets up
the Inquisition against the Vaudois. A.D. 1208. He proclaims a crusade
against them. A.D. 1300. Boniface VIII. introduces the year of jubilee.
A.D. 1305. The Pope's residence is removed to Avignon. A.D. 1377. It is
removed back to Rome. A.D. 1378. The fifty years' schism begins. A.D.
1449. Felix V., the last Antipope, submits to Nicholas V. A.D. 1517. The
Reformation begins. A.D. 1527. Rome is taken and plundered. A.D. 1557.
Charles V. resigns the empire; Ferdinand I. thinks the being crowned by
the Pope superfluous. A.D. 1564. Pius IV. confirms the Council of Trent.
A.D. 1682. Doctrines highly derogatory to the Papal authority are openly
taught in France. A.D. 1713. The constitution Unigenitus. A.D. 1721.
Pope Gregory VII. canonized anew. He who compares this short table with
what will be observed, verse 3, and chap. xvii, 10, will see that the
ascent of the beast out of the sea must needs be fixed toward the
beginning of it; and not higher than Gregory VII., nor lower than
Alexander III. The secular princes now favoured the kingdom of Christ;
but the bishops of Rome vehemently opposed it. These at first were plain
ministers or pastors of the Christian congregation at Rome, but by
degrees they rose to an eminence of honour and power over all their
brethren till, about the time of Gregory VII. (and so ever since) they
assumed all the ensigns of royal majesty; yea, of a majesty and power
far superior to that of all other potentates on earth. We are not here
considering their false doctrines, but their unbounded power. When we
think of those, we are to look at the false prophet, who is also termed
a wild beast at his ascent out of the earth. But the first beast then
properly arose, when, after several preludes thereto, the Pope raised
himself above the emperor. PROP. 7. Hildebrand, or Gregory VII., is the
proper founder of the papal kingdom. All the patrons of the Papacy allow
that he made many considerable additions to it; and this very thing
constituted the beast, by completing the spiritual kingdom: the new
maxims and the new actions of Gregory all proclaim this. Some of his
maxims are,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p2">1. That the bishop of Rome alone is universal
bishop.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p3">2. That he alone can depose bishops, or
receive them again.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p4">3. That he alone has power to make new laws
in the church.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p5">4. That he alone ought to use the ensigns of
royalty.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p6">5. That all princes ought to kiss his
foot.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p7">6. That the name of Pope is the only name
under heaven; and that his name alone should be recited in the
churches.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p8">7. That he has a power to depose
emperors.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p9">8. That no general synod can be convened but
by him.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p10">9. That no book is canonical without his
authority.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p11">10. That none upon earth can repeal his
sentence, but he alone can repeal any sentence.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p12">11. That he is subject to no human
judgment.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p13">12. That no power dare to pass sentence on
one who appeals to the Pope.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p14">13. That all weighty causes everywhere ought
to be referred to him.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p15">14. That the Roman church never did, nor ever
can, err.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p16">15. That the Roman bishop, canonically
ordained, is immediately made holy, by the merits of St. Peter.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p17">16. That he can absolve subjects from their
allegiance. These the most eminent Romish writers own to be his genuine
sayings. And his actions agree with his words. Hitherto the Popes had
been subject to the emperors, though often unwillingly; but now the Pope
began himself, under a spiritual pretext, to act the emperor of the
whole Christian world: the immediate dispute was, about the investiture
of bishops, the right of which each claimed to himself. And now was the
time for the Pope either to give up, or establish his empire forever: to
decide which, Gregory excommunicated the emperor Henry IV.; "having
first," says Platina, "deprived him of all his dignities." The sentence
ran in these terms: "Blessed Peter, prince of the apostles, incline, I
beseech thee, thine ears, and hear me thy servant. In the name of the
omnipotent God, Father, Son, and Holy Ghost, I cast down the emperor
Henry from all imperial and regal authority, and absolve all Christians,
that were his subjects, from the oath whereby they used to swear
allegiance to true kings. And moreover, because he had despised mine,
yea, thy admonitions, I bind him with the bond of an anathema." The same
sentence he repeated at Rome in these terms: "Blessed Peter, prince of
the apostles, and thou Paul, teacher of the gentiles, incline, I beseech
you, your ears to me, and graciously hear me. Henry, whom they call
emperor, hath proudly lifted up his horns and his head against the
church of God, - who came to me, humbly imploring to be absolved from
his excommunication, - I restored him to communion, but not to his
kingdom, - neither did I allow his subjects to return to their
allegiance. Several bishops and princes of Germany, taking this
opportunity, in the room of Henry, justly deposed, chose Rodulph
emperor, who immediately sent ambassadors to me, informing me that he
would rather obey me than accept of a kingdom, and that he should always
remain at the disposal of God and us. Henry then began to be angry, and
at first intreated us to hinder Rodulph from seizing his kingdom. I said
I would see to whom the right belonged, and give sentence which should
be preferred. Henry forbad this. Therefore I bind Henry and all his
favourers with the bond of an anathema, and again take from him all
regal power. I absolve all Christians from their oath of allegiance,
forbid them to obey Henry in anything, and command them to receive
Rodulph as their king. Confirm this, therefore, by your authority, ye
most holy princes of the apostles, that all may now at length know, as
ye have power to bind and loose in heaven, so we have power to give and
take away on earth, empires, kingdoms, principalities, and whatsoever
men can have." When Henry submitted, then Gregory began to reign without
control. In the same year, 1077, on September 1, he fixed a new era of
time, called the Indiction, used at Rome to this day. Thus did the Pope
claim to himself the whole authority over all Christian princes. Thus
did he take away or confer kingdoms and empires, as a king of kings.
Neither did his successors fail to tread in his steps. It is well known,
the following Popes have not been wanting to exercise the same power,
both over kings and emperors. And this the later Popes have been so far
from disclaiming, that three of them have sainted this very Gregory,
namely, Clement VIII., Paul V., and Benedict XIII. Here is then the
beast, that is, the king: in fact such, though not in name: according to
that remarkable observation of Cardinal Bellarmine, "Antichrist will
govern the Roman empire, yet without the name of Roman emperor." His
spiritual title prevented his taking the name, while he exerciseth all
the power. Now Gregory was at the head of this novelty. So Aventine
himself, "Gregory VII was the first founder of the pontifical empire."
Thus the time of the ascent of the beast is clear. The apostasy and
mystery of iniquity gradually increased till he arose, "who opposeth and
exalteth himself above all." <scripRef passage="2 Thess. ii. 4" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p17.1" parsed="|2Thess|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Thess.2.4">2 Thess.
ii, 4</scripRef>. Before the seventh trumpet the adversary wrought more
secretly; but soon after the beginning of this, the beast openly opposes
his kingdom to the kingdom of Christ. PROP 8. The empire of Hildebrand
properly began in the year 1077. Then it was, that upon the emperor's
leaving Italy, Gregory exercised his power to the full. And on the first
of September, in this year, he began his famous epocha. This may be
farther established and explained by the following observations:-</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p18">OBS. 1. The beast is the Romish Papacy, which
has now reigned for some ages. OBS. 2. The beast has seven heads and ten
horns. OBS. 3. The seven heads are seven hills, and also seven kings.
One of the heads could not have been, "as it were, mortally wounded,"
had it been only a hill. OBS. 4. The ascent of the beast out of the sea
is different from his ascent out of the abyss; the Revelation often
mentions both the sea and the abyss but never uses the terms
promiscuously. OBS. 5. The heads of the beast do not begin before his
rise out of the sea, but with it. OBS. 6. These heads, as kings, succeed
each other. OBS. 7. The time which they take up in this succession is
divided into three parts. "Five" of the kings signified thereby "are
fallen: one is, the other is not yet come." OBS. 8. "One is:" namely,
while the angel was speaking this. He places himself and St. John in the
middlemost time, that he might the more commodiously point out the first
time as past, the second as present, the third as future. OBS. 9. The
continuance of the beast is divided in the same manner. The beast "was,
is not, will ascend out of the abyss," chap. xvii, 8, 11. Between these
two verses, that is interposed as parallel with them, "Five are fallen,
one is, the other is not yet come." OBS. 10. Babylon is Rome. All things
which the Revelation says of Babylon, agree to Romans, and Roman only.
It commenced "Babylon," when it commenced "the great." When Babylon sunk
in the east, it arose in the west; and it existed in the time of the
apostles, whose judgment is said to be "avenged on her." OBS. 11. The
beast reigns both before and after the reign of Babylon. First, the
beast reigns, chap. xiii, 1, &amp;c.; then Babylon, chap. xvii, 1,
&amp;c.; and then the beast again, chap. xvii, 8, &amp;c. OBS. 12. The
heads are of the substance of the beast; the horns are not. The wound of
one of the heads is called "the wound of the beast" itself, verse 3; but
the horns, or kings, receive the kingdom "with the beast," chap. xvii,
12. That word alone, "the horns and the beast," chap. xvii, 16,
sufficiently shows them to be something added to him. OBS. 13. The
forty-two months of the beast fall within the first of the three
periods. The beast rose out of the sea in the year 1077. A little after,
power was given him for forty-two months. This power is still in being.
OBS. 14. The time when the beast "is not," and the reign of "Babylon,"
are together. The beast, when risen out of the sea, raged violently,
till "his kingdom was darkened" by the fifth phial. But it was a kingdom
still; and the beast having a kingdom, though darkened, was the beast
still. But it was afterwards said, "the beast was," (was the beast, that
is, reigned,) "and is not;" is not the beast; does not reign, having
lost his kingdom. Why? because "the woman sits upon the beast," who
"sits a queen," reigning over the kings of the earth: till the beast,
rising out of the abyss, and taking with him the ten kings, suddenly
destroys her. OBS. 15. The difference there is between Rome and the
Pope, which has always subsisted, will then be most apparent. Rome,
distinct from the Pope, bears three meanings; the city itself, the Roman
church, and the people of Rome. In the last sense of the word, Rome with
its dutchy, which contained part of Tuscany and Campania, revolted from
the Greek emperor in 726, and became a free state, governed by its
senate. From this time the senate, and not the Pope, enjoyed the supreme
civil power. But in 796, Leo III., being chosen Pope, sent to Charles
the Great, desiring him to come and subdue the senate and people of
Rome, and constrain them to swear allegiance to him. Hence arose a sharp
contention between the Pope and the Roman people, who seized and thrust
him into a monastery. He escaped and fled to the emperor, who quickly
sent him back in great state. In the year 800 the emperor came to Rome,
and shortly after, the Roman people, who had hitherto chosen their own
bishops, and looked upon themselves and their senate as having the same
rights with the ancient senate and people of Rome, chose Charles for
their emperor, and subjected themselves to him, in the same manner as
the ancient Roman did to their emperors. The Pope crowned him, and paid
him homage on his knees, as was formerly done to the Roman emperors: and
the emperor took an oath "to defend the holy Roman church in all its
emoluments." He was also created consul, and styled himself
thenceforward Augustus, Emperor of the Romans. Afterwards he gave the
government of the city and dutchy of Rome to the Pope, yet still subject
to himself. What the Roman church is, as distinct from the Pope,
appears,</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p19">1. When a council is held before the Pope's
confirmation;</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p20">2. When upon a competition, judgment is given
which is the true Pope;</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p21">3. When the See is vacant;</p>

<p class="List5" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p22">4. When the Pope himself is suspected by the
Inquisition.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p23">How Rome, as it is a city, differs from the
Pope, there is no need to show. OBS. 16. In the first and second period
of his duration, the beast is a body of men; in the third, an
individual. The beast with seven heads is the Papacy of many ages: the
seventh head is the man of sin, antichrist. He is a body of men from
chap. xiii, 1 - chap. xvii, 7; he is a body of men and an individual,
chap. xvii, 8 - chap. xvii, 11; he is an individual, chap. xvii, 12 -
chap. xix, 20. OBS. 17. That individual is the seventh head of the
beast, or, the other king after the five and one, himself being the
eighth, though one of the seven. As he is a Pope, he is one of the seven
heads. But he is the eighth, or not a head, but the beast himself, not,
as he is a Pope, but as he bears a new and singular character at his
coming from the abyss. To illustrate this by a comparison: suppose a
tree of seven branches, one of which is much larger than the rest; if
those six are cut away, and the seventh remain, that is the tree. OBS.
18. "He is the wicked one, the man of sin, the son of perdition" usually
termed antichrist. OBS. 19. The ten horns, or kings, "receive power as
kings with the wild beast one hour," chap. xvii, 12; with the individual
beast, "who was not." But he receives his power again, and the kings
with it, who quickly give their new power to him. OBS. 20. The whole
power of the Roman monarchy, divided into ten kingdoms, will be
conferred on the beast, chap. xvii, 13, 16, 17.</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p24">OBS. 21. The ten horns and the beast will
destroy the whore, chap. xvii, 16. OBS. 22. At length the beast, the ten
horns, and the other kings of the earth, will fall in that great
slaughter, chap. xix, 19. OBS. 23. Daniel's fourth beast is the Roman
monarchy, from the beginning of it, till the thrones are set. This,
therefore, comprises both the apocalyptic beast, and the woman, and many
other things. This monarchy is like a river which runs from its fountain
in one channel, but in its course sometimes takes in other rivers,
sometimes is itself parted into several streams, yet is still one
continued river. The Roman power was at first undivided; but it was
afterwards divided into various channels, till the grand division into
the eastern and western empires, which likewise underwent various
changes. Afterward the kings of the Heruli. Goths, Lombards, the exarchs
of Ravenna, the Roman themselves the emperors, French and German,
besides other kings, seized several parts of the Roman power. Now
whatever power the Roman had before Gregory VII., that Daniel's beast
contains; whatever power the Papacy has had from Gregory VII., this the
apocalyptic beast represents, but this very beast (and so Rome with its
last authority) is comprehended under that of Daniel. And upon his heads
a name of blasphemy - To ascribe to a man what belongs to God alone is
blasphemy. Such a name the beast has, not on his horns, nor on one head,
but on all. The beast himself bears that name, and indeed through his
whole duration. This is the name of Papa or Pope; not in the innocent
sense wherein it was formerly given to all bishops, but in that high and
peculiar sense wherein it is now given to the bishop of Rome by himself,
and his followers: a name which comprises the whole pre- eminence of the
highest and most holy father upon earth. Accordingly among the above
cited sayings of Gregory, those two stand together, that his "name alone
should be recited in the churches;" and that it is "the only name in the
world." So both the church and the world were to name no other father on
the face of the earth.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p25">2. The three first beasts in Daniel are like "a leopard,"
"a bear," and "a lion." In all parts, except his feet and mouth, this
beast was like a leopard or female panther; which is fierce as a lion or
bear, but is also swift and subtle. Such is the Papacy, which has partly
by subtilty, partly by force, gained power over so many nations. The
extremely various usages, manners, and ways of the Pope, may likewise be
compared to the spots of the leopard. And his feet were as the feet of a
bear - Which are very strong, and armed with sharp claws. And, as clumsy
as they seem, he can therewith walk, stand upright, climb, or seize
anything. So does this beast seize and take for his prey whatever comes
within the reach of his claws. And his mouth was as the mouth of a lion
- To roar, and to devour. And the dragon - Whose vassal and vicegerent
he is. Gave him his power - His own strength and innumerable forces. And
his throne - So that he might command whatever he would, having great,
absolute authority. The dragon had his throne in heathen Rome, so long
as idolatry and persecution reigned there. And after he was disturbed in
his possession, yet would he never wholly resign, till he gave it to the
beast in Christian Rome, so called.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p26">3. And I saw one - Or the first. Of his heads as it were
wounded - So it appeared as soon as ever it rose. The beast is first
described more generally, then more particularly, both in this and in
the seventeenth chapter. The particular description here respects the
former parts; there, the latter parts of his duration: only that some
circumstances relating to the former are repeated in the seventeenth
chapter. chap. xvii, 1-18 This deadly wound was given him on his first
head by the sword, verse 14; chap. xiii, 14 that is, by the bloody
resistance of the secular potentates, particularly the German emperors.
These had for a long season had the city of Rome, with her bishop, under
their jurisdiction. Gregory determined to cast off this yoke from his
own, and to lay it on the emperor's shoulders. He broke loose, and
excommunicated the emperor, who maintained his right by force, and gave
the Pope such a blow, that one would have thought the beast must have
been killed thereby, immediately after his coming up. But he recovered,
and grew stronger than before. The first head of the beast extends from
Gregory VII., at least to Innocent III. In that tract of time the beast
was much wounded by the emperors. But, notwithstanding, the wound was
healed. Two deadly symptoms attended this wound:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p27">1. Schisms and open ruptures in the church.
For while the emperors asserted their right, there were from the year
1080 to the year 1176 only, five open divisions, and at least as many
antipopes, some of whom were, indeed, the rightful Popes. This was
highly dangerous to the papal kingdoms. But a still more dangerous
symptom was,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p28">2. The rising of the nobility at Rome, who
would not suffer their bishop to be a secular prince, particularly over
themselves. Under Innocent II. they carried their point, re-established
the ancient commonwealth, took away from the Pope the government of the
city, and left him only his episcopal authority. "At this," says the
historian, "Innocent II. and Celestine II. fretted themselves to death:
Lucius II., as he attacked the capitol, wherein the senate was, sword in
hand, was struck with a stone, and died in a few days: Eugene III.,
Alexander III., and Lucius III., were driven out of the city: Urban III.
and Gregory VIII. spent their days in banishment At length they came to
an agreement with Clement III., who was himself a Roman." And the whole
earth - The whole western world. Wondered after the wild beast - That
is, followed him with wonder, in his councils, his crusades, and his
jubilees. This refers not only to the first head, but also to the four
following.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p29">4. And they worshipped the dragon - Even in worshipping the
beast, although they knew it not. And worshipped the wild beast - Paying
him such honour as was not paid to any merely secular potentate. That
very title, "Our most holy Lord," was never given to any other monarch
on earth. Saying, Who is like the wild beast - "Who is like him?" is a
peculiar attribute of God; but that this is constantly attributed to the
beast, the books of all his adherents show.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p30">5. And there was given him - By the dragon, through the
permission of God. A mouth speaking great things and blasphemy - The
same is said of the little horn on the fourth beast in Daniel. Nothing
greater, nothing more blasphemous, can be conceived, than what the Popes
have said of themselves, especially before the Reformation. And
authority was given him forty-two months - The beginning of these is not
to be dated immediately from his ascent out of the sea, but at some
distance from it.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p31">6. To blaspheme his name - Which many of the Popes have
done explicitly, and in the most dreadful manner. And his tabernacle,
even them that dwell in heaven - (For God himself dwelleth in the
inhabitance of heaven.) Digging up the bones of many of them, and
cursing them with the deepest execrations.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p32">7. And it was given him - That is, God permitted him. To
make war with his saints - With the Waldenses and Albigenses. It is a
vulgar mistake, that the Waldenses were so called from Peter Waldo of
Lyons. They were much more ancient than him; and their true name was
Vallenses or Vaudois from their inhabiting the valleys of Lucerne and
Agrogne. This name, Vallenses, after Waldo appeared about the year 1160,
was changed by the Papists into Waldenses, on purpose to represent them
as of modern original. The Albigenses were originally people of
Albigeois, part of Upper Languedoc, where they considerably prevailed,
and possessed several towns in the year 1200. Against these many of the
Popes made open war. Till now the blood of Christians had been shed only
by the heathens or Arians; from this time by scarce any but the Papacy.
In the year 1208 Innocent III. proclaimed a crusade against them. In
June, 1209, the army assembled at Toulouse; from which time abundance of
blood was shed, and the second army of martyrs began to be added to the
first, who had cried "from beneath the altar." And ever since, the beast
has been warring against the saints, and shedding their blood like
water. And authority was given him over every tribe and people -
Particularly in Europe. And when a way was found by sea into the East
Indies, and the West, these also were brought under his authority.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p33">8. And all that dwell upon the earth will worship him - All
will be carried away by the torrent, but the little flock of true
believers. The name of these only is written in the Lamb's book of life.
And if any even of these "make shipwreck of the faith," he will blot
them "out of his book;" although they were written therein from (that
is, before) the foundation of the world, chap. xvii, 8.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p34">9. If any one have an ear, let him hear - It was said
before, "He that hath an ear, let him hear." This expression, if any,
seems to imply, that scarce will any that hath an ear be found. Let him
hear - With all attention the following warning, and the whole
description of the beast,</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p35">10. If any man leadeth into captivity - God will in due
time repay the followers of the beast in their own kind. Meanwhile, here
is the patience and faithfulness of the saints exercised: their
patience, by enduring captivity or imprisonment; their faithfulness, by
resisting unto blood.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p36">11. And I saw another wild beast - So he is once termed to
show his fierceness and strength, but in all other places, "the false
prophet." He comes to confirm the kingdom of the first beast. Coming up
- After the other had long exercised his authority. Out of the earth -
Out of Asia. But he is not yet come, though he cannot be far off for he
is to appear at the end of the forty-two months of the first beast. And
he had two horns like a lamb - A mild, innocent appearance. But he spake
like a dragon - Venomous, fiery, dreadful. So do those who are zealous
for the beast.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p37">12. And he exerciseth all the authority of the first wild
beast - Described in the second, fourth, fifth, and seventh verses.
chap. xiii, 2, 3, 5, 7 Before him - For they are both together. Whose
deadly wound was healed - More throughly healed by means of the second
beast.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p38">13. He maketh fire - Real fire. To come down - By the power
of the devil.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p39">14. Before the wild beast - Whose usurped majesty is
confirmed by these wonders. Saying to them - As if it were from God. To
make an image to the wild beast - Like that of Nebuchadnezzar, whether
of gold, silver, or stone. The original image will be set up where the
beast himself shall appoint. But abundance of copies will be taken,
which may be carried into all parts, like those of Diana of Ephesus.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p40">15. So that the image of the wild beast should speak - Many
instances of this kind have been already among the Papists, as well as
the heathens. And as many as will not worship - When it is required of
them; as it will be of all that buy or sell. Shall be killed - By this
the Pope manifests that he is antichrist, directly contrary to Christ.
It is Christ who shed his own blood; it is antichrist who sheds the
blood of others. And yet, it seems, his last and most cruel persecution
is to come. This persecution, the reverse of all that preceded, will, as
we may gather from many scriptures, fall chiefly on the outward court
worshippers, the formal Christians. It is probable that few real, inward
Christians shall perish by it: on the contrary, those who "watch and
pray always" shall be "accounted worthy to escape all these things, and
to stand before the Son of man," <scripRef passage="Luke xxi. 36" id="i.xxviii.xiv-p40.1" parsed="|Luke|21|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.21.36">Luke
xxi, 36</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p41">16. On their forehead - The most zealous of his followers
will probably choose this. Others may receive it on their hand.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p42">17. That no man might buy or sell - Such edicts have been
published long since against the poor Vaudois. But he that had the mark,
namely, the name of the first beast, or the number of his name - The
name of the beast is that which he bears through his whole duration;
namely, that of Papa or Pope: the number of his name is the whole time
during which he bears this name. Whosoever, therefore, receives the mark
of the beast does as much as if he said expressly, "I acknowledge the
present Papacy, as proceeding from God;" or, "I acknowledge that what
St. Gregory VII. has done, according to his legend, (authorized by
Benedict XIII.,) and what has been maintained in virtue thereof, by his
successors to this day, is from God." By the former, a man hath the name
of the beast as a mark; by the latter, the number of his name. In a
word, to have the name of the beast is, to acknowledge His papal
Holiness; to have the number of his name is, to acknowledge the papal
succession. The second beast will enforce the receiving this mark under
the severest penalties.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xiv-p43">18. Here is the wisdom - To be exercised. "The patience of
the saints" availed against the power of the first beast: the wisdom God
giveth them will avail against the subtilty of the second. Let him that
hath understanding - Which is a gift of God, subservient to that wisdom.
Count the number of the wild beast - Surely none can be blamed for
attempting to obey this command. For it is the number of a man - A
number of such years as are common among men. And his number is six
hundred and sixty-six years - So long shall he endure from his first
appearing.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="29.46%" prev="i.xxviii.xiv" next="i.xxviii.xvi" id="i.xxviii.xv">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xv-p0.1">XIV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XIV" id="i.xxviii.xv-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.14" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p1">1. And I saw on Mount Zion - The heavenly Zion. An hundred
forty-four thousand - Either those out of all mankind who had been the
most eminently holy, or the most holy out of the twelve tribes of Israel
the same that were mentioned, chap. vii, 4, and perhaps also, chap. xvi,
2. But they were then in the world, and were sealed in their foreheads,
to preserve them from the plagues that were to follow. They are now in
safety, and have the name of the Lamb and of his Father written on their
foreheads, as being the redeemed of God and of the Lamb, his now
unalienable property. This prophecy often introduces the inhabitants of
heaven as a kind of chorus with great propriety and elegance. The church
above, making suitable reflections on the grand events which are
foretold in this book, greatly serves to raise the attention of real
Christians, and to teach the high concern they have in them. Thus is the
church on earth instructed, animated, and encouraged, by the sentiments
temper, and devotion of the church in heaven.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p2">2. And I heard a sound out of heaven - Sounding clearer and
clearer: first, at a distance, as the sound of many waters or thunders;
and afterwards, being nearer, it was as of harpers harping on their
harps. It sounded vocally and instrumentally at once.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p3">3. And they - The hundred forty-four thousand-Sing a new
song - and none could learn that song - To sing and play it in the same
manner. But the hundred forty-four thousand who were redeemed from the
earth - From among men; from all sin.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p4">4. These are they who had not been defiled with women - It
seems that the deepest defilement, and the most alluring temptation, is
put for every other. They are virgins - Unspotted souls; such as have
preserved universal purity. These are they who follow the Lamb - Who are
nearest to him. This is not their character, but their reward
Firstfruits - Of the glorified spirits. Who is ambitious to be of this
number?</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p5">5. And in their mouth there was found no guile - Part for
the whole. Nothing untrue, unkind, unholy. They are without fault -
Having preserved inviolate a virgin purity both of soul and body.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p6">6. And I saw another angel - A second is mentioned, verse
8; a third, verse 9. chap. xiv, 8, 9 These three denote great messengers
of God with their assistants; three men who bring messages from God to
men. The first exhorts to the fear and worship of God; the second
proclaims the fall of Babylon; the third gives warning concerning the
beast. Happy are they who make the right use of these divine messages!
Flying - Going on swiftly. In the midst of heaven - Breadthways. Having
an everlasting gospel - Not the gospel, properly so called; but a
gospel, or joyful message, which was to have an influence on all ages.
To preach to every nation, and tribe, and tongue, and people - Both to
Jew and gentile, even as far as the authority of the beast had
extended.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p7">7. Fear God and give glory to him; for the hour of his
judgment is come - The joyful message is properly this, that the hour of
God's judgment is come. And hence is that admonition drawn, Fear God and
give glory to him. They who do this will not worship the beast, neither
any image or idol whatsoever. And worship him that made - Whereby he is
absolutely distinguished from idols of every kind. The heaven, and the
earth, and the sea, and fountains of water - And they who worship him
shall be delivered when the angels pour out their phials on the earth,
sea, fountains of water, on the sun, and in the air.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p8">8. And another angel followed, saying, Babylon is fallen -
With the overthrow of Babylon, that of all the enemies of Christ, and,
consequently, happier times, are connected. Babylon the great - So the
city of Rome is called upon many accounts. Babylon was magnificent,
strong, proud, powerful. So is Rome also. Babylon was first, Rome
afterwards, the residence of the emperors of the world. What Babylon was
to Israel of old, Roman hath been both to the literal and spiritual
"Israel of God." Hence the liberty of the ancient Jews was connected
with the overthrow of the Babylonish empire. And when Rome is finally
overthrown, then the people of God will be at liberty. Whenever Babylon
is mentioned in this book, the great is added, to teach us that Rome
then commenced Babylon, when it commenced the great city; when it
swallowed up the Grecian monarchy and its fragments, Syria in
particular; and, in consequence of this, obtained dominion over
Jerusalem about sixty years before the birth of Christ. Then it began,
but it will not cease to be Babylon till it is finally destroyed. Its
spiritual greatness began in the fifth century, and increased from age
to age. It seems it will come to its utmost height just before its final
overthrow. Her fornication is her idolatry; invocation of saints and
angels; worship of images; human traditions; with all that outward pomp,
yea, and that fierce and bloody zeal, wherewith she pretends to serve
God. But with spiritual fornication, as elsewhere, so in Rome, fleshly
fornication is joined abundantly. Witness the stews there, licensed by
the Pope, which are no inconsiderable branch of his revenue. This is
fitly compared, to wine, because of its intoxicating nature. Of this
wine she hath, indeed, made all nations drink - More especially by her
later missions. We may observe, this making them drink is not ascribed
to the beast, but to Babylon. For Rome itself, the Roman inquisitions,
congregations, and Jesuits, continually propagate the idolatrous
doctrines and practices, with or without the consent of this or that
Pope, who himself is not secure from their censure.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p9">9. And a third angel followed - At no great distance of
time. Saying, If any one worship the wild beast - This worship consists,
partly in an inward submission, a persuasion that all who are subject to
Christ must be subject to the beast or they cannot receive the
influences of divine grace, or, as their expression is, there is no
salvation out of their church; partly in a suitable outward reverence to
the beast himself, and consequently to his image.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p10">10. He shall drink - With Babylon, chap. xvi, 19. And shall
be tormented - With the beast, chap. xx, 10. In all the scripture there
is not another so terrible threatening as this. And God by this greater
fear arms his servants against the fear of the beast. The wrath of God,
which is poured unmixed - Without any mixture of mercy; without hope.
Into the cup of his indignation - And is no real anger implied in all
this? O what will not even wise men assert, to serve an hypothesis!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p11">11. And the smoke - From the fire and brimstone wherein
they are tormented. Ascendeth forever and ever - God grant thou and I
may never try the strict, literal eternity of this torment!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p12">12. Here is the patience of the saints - Seen, in suffering
all things rather than receive this mark. Who keep the commandments of
God - The character of all true saints; and particularly the great
command to believe in Jesus.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p13">13. And I heard a voice - This is most seasonably heard
when the beast is in his highest power and fury. Out of heaven -
Probably from a departed saint. Write - He was at first commanded to
write the whole book. Whenever this is repeated it denotes something
peculiarly observable. Happy are the dead - From henceforth
particularly:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xv-p14">1. Because they escape the approaching
calamities:</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xv-p15">2. Because they already enjoy so near an
approach to glory. Who die in the Lord - In the faith of the Lord Jesus.
For they rest - No pain, no purgatory follows; but pure, unmixed
happiness. From their labours - And the more labourious their life was,
the sweeter is their rest. How different this state from that of those,
verse 11, chap. xiv, 11 who "have no rest day or night!" Reader, which
wilt thou choose? Their works - Each one's peculiar works. Follow - or
accompany them; that is, the fruit of their works. Their works do not go
before to procure them admittance into the mansions of joy; but they
follow them when admitted.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p16">14. In the following verses, under the emblem of an harvest
and a vintage, are signified two general visitations; first, many good
men are taken from the earth by the harvest; then many sinners during
the vintage. The latter is altogether a penal visitation; the former
seems to be altogether gracious. Here is no reference in either to the
day of judgment, but to a season which cannot be far off. And I saw a
white cloud - An emblem of mercy. And on the cloud sat one like a son of
man - An angel in an human shape, sent by Christ, the Lord both of the
vintage and of the harvest. Having a golden crown on his head - In token
of his high dignity. And a sharp sickle in his hand - The sharper the
welcomer to the righteous.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p17">15. And another angel came out of the temple - "Which is in
heaven," verse 17. chap. xiv, 17 Out of which came the judgments of God
in the appointed seasons.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p18">16. Crying - By the command of God. Thrust in thy sickle,
for the harvest is ripe - This implies an high degree of holiness in
those good men, and an earnest desire to be with God.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p19">18. And another angel from the altar - Of burnt offering;
from whence the martyrs had cried for vengeance. Who had power over fire
- As "the angel of the waters," chap. xvi, 5, had over water. Cried,
saying, Lop off the clusters of the vine of the earth - All the wicked
are considered as constituting one body.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xv-p20">20. And the winepress was trodden - By the Son of God,
chap. xix, 15. Without the city - Jerusalem. They to whom St. John
writes, when a man said, "The city," immediately understood this. And
blood came out of the winepress, even to the horses' bridles - So deep
at its first flowing from the winepress! One thousand six hundred
furlongs - So far! at least two hundred miles, through the whole land of
Palestine.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="29.64%" prev="i.xxviii.xv" next="i.xxviii.xvii" id="i.xxviii.xvi">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xvi-p0.1">XV</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XV" id="i.xxviii.xvi-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.15" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xvi-p1">1. And I saw seven holy angels having the seven last
plagues - Before they had the phials, which were as instruments whereby
those plagues were to be conveyed. They are termed the last, because by
them the wrath of God is fulfilled - Hitherto. God had born his enemies
with much longsuffering; but now his wrath goes forth to the uttermost,
pouring plagues on the earth from one end to the other, and round its
whole circumference. But, even after these plagues, the holy wrath of
God against his other enemies does not cease, chap. xx, 15.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvi-p2">2. The song was sung while the angels were coming out, with
their plagues, who are therefore mentioned both before and after it,
verses 1-6. chap. xv, 1-6, And I saw as it were a sea of glass mingled
with fire - It was before "clear as crystal," chap. iv, 6, but now
mingled with fire, which devours the adversaries. And them that gained,
or were gaining, the victory over the wild beast - More of whom were yet
to come. The mark of the beast, the mark of his name, and the number of
his name, seem to mean here nearly the same thing. Standing at the sea
of glass - Which was before the throne. Having the harps of God - Given
by him, and appropriated to his praise.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvi-p3">3. And they sing the song of Moses - So called, partly from
its near agreement, with the words of that song which he sung after
passing the Red Sea, <scripRef passage="Exod. xv. 11" id="i.xxviii.xvi-p3.1" parsed="|Exod|15|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.15.11">Exod. xv,
11</scripRef>, and of that which he taught the children of Israel a little
before his death, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 3, 4" id="i.xxviii.xvi-p3.2" parsed="|Deut|32|3|32|4" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.3-Deut.32.4">Deut.
xxxii, 3, 4</scripRef>. But chiefly because Moses was the minister and
representative of the Jewish church, as Christ is of the church
universal. Therefore it is also termed the sons of the Lamb. It consists
of six parts, which answer each other: 1. Great and wonderful are thy.
2. For thou only art gracious. works, Lord God Almighty. 3. Just and true
are thy ways, O. 4. For all the nations shall come King of the nations
and worship before thee. 5. Who would not fear thee, O. 6. For thy
judgments are made Lord, and glorify thy name? manifest. We know and
acknowledge that all thy works in and toward all the creatures are great
and wonderful; that thy ways with all the children of men, good and
evil, are just and true. For thou only art gracious - And this grace is
the spring of all those wonderful works, even of his destroying the
enemies of his people. Accordingly in <scripRef passage="Psalm cxxxvi. 1-26" id="i.xxviii.xvi-p3.3" parsed="|Ps|136|1|136|26" osisRef="Bible:Ps.136.1-Ps.136.26">Psalm cxxxvi, 1-26</scripRef>., that clause, "For his mercy endureth forever," is
subjoined to the thanksgiving for his works of vengeance as well as for
his delivering the righteous. For all the nations shall come and worship
before thee - They shall serve thee as their king with joyful reverence.
This is a glorious testimony of the future conversion of all the
heathens. The Christians are now a little flock: they who do not worship
God, an immense multitude. But all the nations shall come, from all
parts of the earth, to worship him and glorify his name. For thy
judgments are made manifest - And then the inhabitants of the earth will
at length learn to fear him.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvi-p4">5. After these things the temple of the tabernacle of the
testimony - The holiest of all. Was opened - Disclosing a new theatre
for the coming forth of the judgments of God now made manifest.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvi-p5">6. And the seven angels came out of the temple - As having
received their instructions from the oracle of God himself. St. John saw
them in heaven, verse 1, chap. xv, 1 before they went into the temple.
They appeared in habits like those the high priest wore when he went
into the most holy place to consult the oracle. In this was the visible
testimony of God's presence. Clothed in pure white linen - Linen is the
habit of service and attendance. Pure - unspotted, unsullied. White - Or
bright and shining, which implies much more than bare innocence. And
having their breasts girt with golden girdles - In token of their high
dignity and glorious rest.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvi-p6">7. And one of the four living creatures gave the seven
angels - After they were come out of the temple. Seven golden phials -
Or bowls. The Greek word signifies vessels broader at the top than at
the bottom. Full of the wrath of God, who liveth forever and ever - A
circumstance which adds greatly to the dreadfulness of his wrath.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvi-p7">8. And the temple was filled with smoke - The cloud of
glory was the visible manifestation of God's presence in the tabernacle
and temple. It was a sign of protection at erecting the tabernacle and
at the dedication of the temple. But in the judgment of Korah the glory
of the Lord appeared, when he and his companions were swallowed up by
the earth. So proper is the emblem of smoke from the glory of God, or
from the cloud of glory, to express the execution of judgment, as well
as to be a sign of favour. Both proceed from the power of God, and in
both he is glorified. And none - Not even of those who ordinarily stood
before God. Could go into the temple - That is, into the inmost part of
it. Till the seven plagues of the seven angels were fulfilled - Which
did not take up a long time, like the seven trumpets, but swiftly
followed each other.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="29.72%" prev="i.xxviii.xvi" next="i.xxviii.xviii" id="i.xxviii.xvii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xvii-p0.1">XVI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XVI" id="i.xxviii.xvii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.16" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p1">1. Pour out the seven phials - The epistles to the seven
churches are divided into three and four: the seven seals, and so the
trumpets and phials, into four and three. The trumpets gradually, and in
a long tract of time, overthrow the kingdom of the world: the phials
destroy chiefly the beast and his followers, with a swift and impetuous
force. The four first affect the earth, the sea, the rivers, the sun;
the rest fall elsewhere, and are much more terrible.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p2">2. And the first went - So the second, third, &amp;c.,
without adding angel, to denote the utmost swiftness; of which this also
is a token, that there is no period of time mentioned in the pouring out
of each phial. They have a great resemblance to the plagues of Egypt,
which the Hebrews generally suppose to have been a month distant from
each other. Perhaps so may the phials; but they are all yet to come. And
poured out his phial upon the earth - Literally taken. And there came a
grievous ulcer - As in Egypt, <scripRef passage="Exod. ix. 10, 11" id="i.xxviii.xvii-p2.1" parsed="|Exod|9|10|9|11" osisRef="Bible:Exod.9.10-Exod.9.11">Exod.
ix, 10, 11</scripRef>. On the men who had the mark of the wild beast - All of
them, and them only. All those plagues seem to be described in proper,
not figurative, words.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p3">3. The second poured out his phial upon the sea - As
opposed to the dry land. And it become blood, as of a dead man - Thick,
congealed, and putrid. And every living soul - Men, beasts, and fishes,
whether on or in the sea, died.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p4">4. The third poured out his phial on the rivers and
fountains of water - Which were over all the earth. And they became
blood - So that none could drink thereof.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p5">5. The Gracious one - So he is styled when his judgments
are abroad, and that with a peculiar propriety. In the beginning of the
book he is termed "The Almighty." In the time of his patience, he is
praised for his power, which otherwise might then be less regarded. In
the time of his taking vengeance, for his mercy. Of his power there
could then be no doubt.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p6">6. Thou hast given then, blood to drink - Men do not drink
out of the sea, but out of fountains and rivers. Therefore this is fitly
added here. They are worthy - Is subjoined with a beautiful
abruptness.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p7">7. Yea - Answering the angel of the waters, and affirming
of God's judgments in general, what he had said of one particular
judgment.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p8">8. The fourth poured out his phial upon the sun - Which was
likewise affected by the fourth trumpet. There is also a plain
resemblance between the first, second, and third phials, and the first,
second, and third trumpet. And it was given him - The angel. To scorch
the men - Who had the mark of the beast. With fire - As well as with the
beams of the sun. So these four phials affected earth, water, fire, and
air.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p9">9. And the men blasphemed God, who had power over these
plagues - They could not but acknowledge the hand of God, yet did they
harden themselves against him.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p10">10. The four first phials are closely connected together;
the fifth concerns the throne of the beast, the sixth the Mahometans,
the seventh chiefly the heathens. The four first phials and the four
first trumpets go round the whole earth; the three last phials and the
three last trumpets go lengthways over the earth in a straight line. The
fifth poured out his phial upon the throne of the wild beast - It is not
said, "on the beast and his throne." Perhaps the sea will then be
vacant. And his kingdom was darkened - With a lasting, not a transient,
darkness. However the beast as yet has his kingdom. Afterward the woman
sits upon the beast. and then it is said, "The wild beast is not," chap.
xvii, 3, 7, 8.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p11">11. And they - His followers. Gnawed their tongues - Out of
furious impatience. Because of their pains and because of their ulcers -
Now mentioned together, and in the plural number, to signify that they
were greatly heightened and multiplied.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p12">12. And the sixth poured out his phial upon the great river
Euphrates - Affected also by the sixth trumpet. And the water of it -
And of all the rivers that flow into it. Was dried up - The far greater
part of the Turkish empire lies on this side the Euphrates. The Romish
and Mahometan affairs ran nearly parallel to each other for several
ages. In the seventh century was Mahomet himself; and, a little before
him, Boniface III., with his universal bishopric. In the eleventh, both
the Turks and Gregory VII. carried all before them. In the year 1300,
Boniface appeared with his two swords at the newly-erected jubilee. In
the self-same year arose the Ottoman Porte; yea, and on the same day.
And here the phial, poured out on the throne of the beast, is
immediately followed by that poured out on the Euphrates; that the way
of the kings from the east might be prepared - Those who lie east from
the Euphrates, in Persia, India, &amp;c., who will rush blindfold upon
the plagues which are ready for them, toward the Holy Land, which lies
west of the Euphrates.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p13">13. Out of the mouth of the dragon, the wild beast, and the
false prophet - It seems, the dragon fights chiefly against God; the
beast, against Christ; the false prophet, against the Spirit of truth;
and that the three unclean spirits which come from them, and exactly
resemble them, endeavour to blacken the works of creation, of
redemption, and of sanctification. The false prophet - So is the second
beast frequently named, after the kingdom of the first is darkened; for
he can then no longer prevail by main strength, and so works by lies and
deceit. Mahomet was first a false prophet, and afterwards a powerful
prince: but this beast was first powerful as a prince; afterwards a
false prophet, a teacher of lies. Like frogs - Whose abode is in fens,
marshes, and other unclean places. To the kings of the whole world -
Both Mahometan and pagan. To gather them - To the assistance of their
three principals.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p14">15. Behold, I come as a thief - Suddenly, unexpectedly.
Observe the beautiful abruptness. I - Jesus Christ. Hear him. Happy is
he that watcheth. - Looking continually for him that "cometh quickly."
And keepeth on his garments - Which men use to put off when they sleep.
Lest he walk naked, and they see his shame - Lest he lose the graces
which he takes no care to keep, and others see his sin and
punishment.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p15">16. And they gathered them together to Armageddon -
Mageddon, or Megiddo, is frequently mentioned in the Old Testament.
Armageddon signifies the city or the mountain of Megiddo; to which the
valley of Megiddo adjoined. This was a place well known in ancient times
for many memorable occurrences; in particular, the slaughter of the
kings of Canaan, related, <scripRef passage="Judg. v. 19" id="i.xxviii.xvii-p15.1" parsed="|Judg|5|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.5.19">Judg. v, 19</scripRef>. Here the narrative breaks off. It is resumed, chap. xix,
19.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p16">17. And the seventh poured out his phial upon the air -
Which encompasses the whole earth. This is the most weighty phial of
all, and seems to take up more time than any of the preceding. It is
done - What was commanded, verse 1. chap. xvi, 1 The phials are poured
out.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p17">18. A great earthquake, such as had not been since men were
upon the earth - It was therefore a literal, not figurative,
earthquake.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p18">19. And the great city - Namely, Jerusalem, here opposed to
the heathen cities in general, and in particular to Rome. And the cities
of the nations fell - Were utterly overthrown. And Babylon was
remembered before God - He did not forget the vengeance which was due to
her, though the execution of it was delayed.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p19">20. Every island and mountain was "moved out of its place,"
chap. vi, 14; but here they all flee away. What a change must this make
in the face of the terraqueous globe! And yet the end of the world is
not come.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xvii-p20">21. And a great hail falleth out of heaven - From which
there was no defense. From the earthquake men would fly into the fields;
but here also they are met by the hail: nor were they secure if they
returned into the houses, when each hail-stone weighed sixty pounds.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="29.86%" prev="i.xxviii.xvii" next="i.xxviii.xix" id="i.xxviii.xviii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xviii-p0.1">XVII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XVII" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.17" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p1">1. And there came one of the seven angels, saying, Come
hither - This relation concerning the great whore, and that concerning
the wife of the Lamb, chap. xxi, 9, 10, have the same introduction, in
token of the exact opposition between them. I will show thee the
judgment of the great whore - Which is now circumstantially described.
That sitteth as a queen - In pomp, power, ease, and luxury. Upon many
waters - Many people and nations, verse 15. chap. xvii, 15</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p2">2. With whom the kings of the earth - Both ancient and
modern, for many ages. Have committed fornication - By partaking of her
idolatry and various wickedness. And the inhabitants of the earth - The
common people. Have been made drunk with the wine of her fornication -
No wine can more thoroughly intoxicate those who drink it, than false
zeal does the followers of the great whore.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p3">3. And he carried me away - In the vision. Into a
wilderness - The campagna di Romansa, the country round about Rome, is
now a wilderness, compared to what it was once. And I saw a woman - Both
the scripture and other writers frequently represent a city under this
emblem. Sitting upon a scarlet wild beast - The same which is described
in the thirteenth chapter. chap. xiii, 1-18 But he was there described
as he carried on his own designs only: here, as he is connected with the
whore. There is, indeed, a very close connection between them; the seven
heads of the beast being "seven hills on which the woman sitteth." And
yet there is a very remarkable difference between them, - between the
papal power and the city of Rome. This woman is the city of Rome, with
its buildings and inhabitants; especially the nobles. The beast, which
is now scarlet-coloured, (bearing the bloody livery, as well as the
person, of the woman,) appears very different from before. Therefore St.
John says at first sight, I saw a beast, not the beast, full of names of
blasphemy - He had before "a name of blasphemy upon his head," chap.
xiii, i, now he has many. From the time of Hildebrand, the blasphemous
titles of the Pope have been abundantly multiplied. Having seven heads -
Which reach in a succession from his ascent out of the sea to his being
cast into the lake of fire. And ten horns - Which are contemporary with
each other, and belong to his last period.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p4">4. And the woman was arrayed - With the utmost pomp and
magnificence. In purple and scarlet - These were the colours of the
imperial habit: the purple, in times of peace; and the scarlet, in times
of war. Having in her hand a golden cup - Like the ancient Babylon, <scripRef passage="Jer. li. 7" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p4.1" parsed="|Jer|51|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.51.7">Jer. li, 7</scripRef>. Full of abominations - The most abominable doctrines as
well as practices.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p5">5. And on her forehead a name written - Whereas the saints
have the name of God and the Lamb on their foreheads. Mystery - This
very word was inscribed on the front of the Pope's mitre, till some of
the Reformers took public notice of it. Babylon the great - Benedict
XIII., in his proclamation of the jubilee, A.D. 1725, explains this
sufficiently. His words are, "To this holy city, famous for the memory
of so many holy martyrs, run with religious alacrity. Hasten to the
place which the Lord hath chose. Ascend to this new Jerusalem, whence
the law of the Lord and the light of evangelical truth hath flowed forth
into all nations, from the very first beginning of the church: the city
most rightfully called 'The Palace,' placed for the pride of all ages,
the city of the Lord, the Sion of the Holy One of Israel. This catholic
and apostolical Roman church is the head of the world, the mother of all
believers, the faithful interpreter of God and mistress of all
churches." But God somewhat varies the style. The mother of harlots -
The parent, ringleader, patroness, and nourisher of many daughters, that
losely copy after her. And abominations - Of every kind, spiritual and
fleshly. Of the earth - In all lands. In this respect she is indeed
catholic or universal.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p6">6. And I saw the woman drunk with the blood of the saints -
So that Rome may well be called, "The slaughter-house of the martyrs."
She hath shed much Christian blood in every age; but at length she is
even drunk with it, at the time to which this vision refers. The
witnesses of Jesus - The preachers of his word. And I wondered
exceedingly - At her cruelty and the patience of God.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p7">7. I will tell thee the mystery - The hidden meaning of
this.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p8">8. The beast which thou sawest (namely, verse 3) chap.
xvii, 3 was, &amp;c. This is a very observable and punctual description
of the beast, verses 8, 10, 11. chap. xvii, 8, 10, 11 His whole duration
is here divided into three periods, which are expressed in a fourfold
manner.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p9">I. He,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p10">1. Was; 2 And is not;</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p11">3. And will ascend out of the bottomless pit,
and go into perdition.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p12">II. He,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p13">1. Was;</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p14">2. And is not;</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p15">3. And will be again.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p16">III. The seven heads are seven hills and
seven kings:</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p17">1. Five are fallen;</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p18">2. One is;</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p19">3. The other is not come; and when he cometh,
he must continue a short space.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p20">IV. He,</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p21">1. Was;</p>

<p class="List4" id="i.xxviii.xviii-p22">2. And is not; 3 Even he is the eighth, and
is one of the seven, and goeth into perdition. The first of these three
is described in the thirteenth chapter. chap. xiii, 1-18 This was past
when the angel spoke to St. John. The second was then in its course; the
third woe to come. And is not - The fifth phial brought darkness upon
his kingdom: the woman took this advantage to seat herself upon him.
Then it might be said, He is not. Yet shall he afterwards ascend out of
the bottomless pit - Arise again with diabolical strength and fury. But
he will not reign long: soon after his ascent he goeth into perdition
forever.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p23">9. Here is the mind that hath wisdom - Only those who are
wise will understand this. The seven heads are seven hills.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p24">10. And they are seven kings - Anciently there were royal
palaces on all the seven Roman bills. These were the Palatine,
Capitoline, Coelian, Exquiline, Viminal, Quirinal, Aventine hills. But
the prophecy respects the seven hills at the time of the beast, when the
Palatine was deserted and the Vatican in use. Not that the seven heads
mean hills distinct from kings; but they have a compound meaning,
implying both together. Perhaps the first head of the beast is the
Coelian hill, and on it the Lateran, with Gregory VII. and his
successors; the second, the Vatican with the church of St. Peter, chosen
by Boniface VIII. the third, the Quirinal, with the church of St. Mark,
and the Quirinal palace built by Paul II. and the fourth, the Exquiline
hill, with the temple of St. Maria Maggiore, where Paul V. reigned. The
fifth will be added hereafter. Accordingly, in the papal register, four
periods are observable since Gregory VII. In the first almost all the
bulls made in the city are dated in the Lateran; in the second, at St.
Peter's; in the third, at St. Mark's, or in the Quirinal; in the fourth,
at St. Maria Maggiore. But no fifth, sixth, or seventh hill has yet been
the residence of any Pope. Not that the hill was deserted, when another
was made the papal residence; but a new one was added to the other
sacred palaces. Perhaps the times hitherto mentioned might be fixed
thus:- 1058. Wings are given to the woman. 1077. The beast ascends out
of the sea. 1143. The forty-two months begin. 1810. The forty-two
months end. 1832. The beast ascends out of the bottomless pit. 1836. The
beast finally overthrown. The fall of those five kings seems to imply,
not only the death of the Popes who reigned on those hills, but also
such a disannulling of all they had done there, that it will be said,
The beast is not; the royal power, which had so long been lodged in the
Pope, being then transferred to the city. One is, the other is not yet
come - These two are remarkably distinguished from the five preceding,
whom they succeed in their turns. The former of them will continue not a
short space, as may be gathered from what is said of the latter: the
former is under the government of Babylon; the latter is with the beast.
In this second period, one is, at the same time that the beast is not.
Even then there will be a Pope, though not with the power which his
predecessors had. And he will reside on one of the remaining hills,
leaving the seventh for his successor.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p25">11. And the wild beast that was, and is not, even he is the
eighth - When the time of his not being is over. The beast consists, as
it were, of eight parts. The seven heads are seven of them; and the
eighth is his whole body, or the beast himself. Yet the beast himself,
though he is in a sense termed the eighth, is of the seven, yea,
contains them all. The whole succession of Popes from Gregory VII. are
undoubtedly antichrist. Yet this hinders not, but that the last Pope in
this succession will be more eminently the antichrist, the man of sin,
adding to that of his predecessors a peculiar degree of wickedness from
the bottomless pit. This individual person, as Pope, is the seventh head
of the beast; as the man of sin, he is the eighth, or the beast
himself.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p26">12. The ten horns are ten kings - It is nowhere said that
these horns are on the beast, or on his heads. And he is said to have
them, not as he is one of the seven, but as he is the eighth. They are
ten secular potentates, contemporary with, not succeeding, each other,
who receive authority as kings with the beast, probably in some
convention, which, after a very short space, they will deliver up to the
beast. Because of their short continuance, only authority as kings, not
a kingdom, is ascribed to them. While they retain this authority
together with the beast, he will be stronger than ever before; but far
stronger still, when their power is also transferred to him.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p27">13. In the thirteenth and fourteenth verses chap. xvii, 13,
14 is summed up what is afterwards mentioned, concerning the horns and
the beast, in this and the two following chapters. These have one mind,
and give - They all, with one consent, give their warlike power and
royal authority to the wild beast.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p28">14. These - Kings with the beast. He is Lord of lords -
Rightful sovereign of all, and ruling all things well. And King of kings
- As a king he fights with and conquers all his enemies. And they that
are with him - Beholding his victory, are such as were, while in the
body, called, by his word and Spirit. And chosen - Taken out of the
world, when they were enabled to believe in him. And faithful - Unto
death.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p29">15. People, and multitudes, and nations, and tongues - It
is not said tribes: for Israel hath nothing to do with Rome in
particular.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p30">16. And shall eat her flesh - Devour her immense
riches.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p31">17. For God hath put it into their heart - Which indeed no
less than almighty power could have effected. To execute his sentence -
till the words of God - Touching the overthrow of all his enemies,
should be fulfilled.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xviii-p32">18. The woman is the great city, which reigneth - Namely,
while the beast "is not," and the woman "sitteth upon him."</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="30.05%" prev="i.xxviii.xviii" next="i.xxviii.xx" id="i.xxviii.xix">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xix-p0.1">XVIII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XVIII" id="i.xxviii.xix-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.18" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p1">1. And I saw another angel coming down out of heaven -
Termed another, with respect to him who "came down out of heaven," chap.
x, 1. And the earth was enlightened with his glory - To make his coming
more conspicuous. If such be the lustre of the servant, what images can
display the majesty of the Lord, who has "thousand thousands" of those
glorious attendants "ministering to him, and ten thousand times ten
thousand standing before him?"</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p2">2. And he cried, Babylon is fallen - This fall was
mentioned before, chap. xiv, 8; but is now declared at large. And is
become an habitation - A free abode. Of devils, and an hold - A prison.
Of every unclean spirit - Perhaps confined there where they had once
practiced all uncleanness, till the judgment of the great day. How many
horrid inhabitants hath desolate Babylon! of invisible beings, devils,
and unclean spirits; of visible, every unclean beast, every filthy and
hateful bird. Suppose, then, Babylon to mean heathen Rome; what have the
Romanists gained, seeing from the time of that destruction, which they
say is past, these are to be its only inhabitants forever.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p3">4. And I heard another voice - Of Christ, whose people,
secretly scattered even there, are warned of her approaching
destruction. That ye be not partakers of her sins - That is, of the
fruits of them. What a remarkable providence it was that the Revelation
was printed in the midst of Spain, in the great Polyglot Bible, before
the Reformation! Else how much easier had it been for the Papists to
reject the whole book, than it is to evade these striking parts of
it.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p4">5. Even to heaven - An expression which implies the highest
guilt.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p5">6. Reward her - This God speaks to the executioners of his
vengeance. Even as she hath rewarded - Others; in particular, the saints
of God. And give her double - This, according to the Hebrew idiom,
implies only a full retaliation.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p6">7. As much as she hath glorified herself - By pride, and
pomp, and arrogant boasting. And lived deliciously - In all kinds of
elegance, luxury, and wantonness. So much torment give her -
Proportioning the punishment to the sin. Because she saith in her heart
- As did ancient Babylon, <scripRef passage="Isai xlvii. 8, 9" id="i.xxviii.xix-p6.1" parsed="|Isa|47|8|47|9" osisRef="Bible:Isa.47.8-Isa.47.9">Isai
xlvii, 8, 9</scripRef>. I sit - Her usual style. Hence those expressions, "The
chair, the seat of Rome: he sat so many years." As a queen - Over many
kings, "mistress of all churches; the supreme; the infallible; the only
spouse of Christ; out of which there is no salvation." And am no widow -
But the spouse of Christ. And shall see no sorrow - From the death of my
children, or any other calamity; for God himself will defend "the
church."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p7">8. Therefore - as both the natural and judicial consequence
of this proud security Shall her plagues come - The death of her
children, with an incapacity of bearing more. Sorrow - of every kind.
And famine - In the room of luxurious plenty: the very things from which
she imagined herself to be most safe. For strong is the Lord God who
judgeth her - Against whom therefore all her strength, great as it is,
will not avail.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p8">10. Thou strong city - Rome was anciently termed by its
inhabitants, Valentia, that is, strong. And the word Rome itself, in
Greek, signifies strength. This name was given it by the Greek
strangers.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p9">12. Merchandise of gold, &amp;c. - Almost all these are
still in use at Rome, both in their idolatrous service, and in common
life. Fine linen - The sort of it mentioned in the original is exceeding
costly. Thyine wood - A sweet-smelling wood not unlike citron, used in
adorning magnificent palaces. Vessels of most precious wood - Ebony, in
particular, which is often mentioned with ivory: the one excelling in
whiteness, the other in blackness; and both in uncommon smoothness.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p10">13. Amomum - A shrub whose wood is a fine perfume. And
beasts - Cows and oxen. And of chariots - a purely Latin word is here
inserted in the Greek. This St. John undoubtedly used on purpose, in
describing the luxury of Rome. And of bodies - A common term for slaves.
And souls of men - For these also are continually bought and sold at
Rome. And this of all others is the most gainful merchandise to the
Roman traffickers.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p11">14. And the fruits - From what was imported they proceed to
the domestic delicates of Rome; none of which is in greater request
there, than the particular sort which is here mentioned. The word
properly signifies, pears, peaches, nectarines, and all of the apple and
plum kinds. And all things that are dainty - To the taste. And splendid
- To the sight; as clothes, buildings, furniture.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p12">19. And they cast dust on their heads - As mourners. Most
of the expressions here used in describing the downfall of Babylon are
taken from Ezekiel's description of the downfall of Tyre, <scripRef passage="Ezek. xxvi. 1" id="i.xxviii.xix-p12.1" parsed="|Ezek|26|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.26.1">Ezek. xxvi, 1</scripRef> - <scripRef passage="Ezek. xxviii. 19" id="i.xxviii.xix-p12.2" parsed="|Ezek|28|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.28.19">Ezek. xxviii, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p13">20. Rejoice over her, thou heaven - That is, all the
inhabitants of it; and more especially, ye saints; and among the saints
still more eminently, ye apostles and prophets.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p14">21. And a mighty angel took up a stone, and threw it into
the sea - By a like emblem Jeremiah fore-showed the fall of the Chaldean
Babylon, <scripRef passage="Jer. li. 63, 64" id="i.xxviii.xix-p14.1" parsed="|Jer|51|63|51|64" osisRef="Bible:Jer.51.63-Jer.51.64">Jer. li, 63,
64</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p15">22. And the voice of harpers - Players on stringed
instruments. And musicians - Skilful singers in particular. And pipers -
Who played on flutes, chiefly on mournful, whereas trumpeters played on
joyful, occasions. Shall be heard no more in thee; and no artificer -
Arts of every kind, particularly music, sculpture, painting, and
statuary, were there carried to their greatest height. No, nor even the
sound of a mill-stone shall be heard any more in thee - Not only the
arts that adorn life, but even those employments without which it cannot
subsist, will cease from thee forever. All these expressions denote
absolute and eternal desolation. The voice of harpers - Music was the
entertainment of the rich and great; trade, the business of men of
middle rank; preparing bread and the necessaries of life, the employment
of the lowest people: marriages, in which lamps and songs were known
ceremonies, are the means of peopling cities, as new births supply the
place of those that die. The desolation of Rome is therefore described
in such a manner, as to show that neither rich nor poor, neither persons
of middle rank, nor those of the lowest condition, should be able to
live there any more. Neither shall it be repeopled by new marriages, but
remain desolate and uninhabited forever.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p16">23. For thy merchants were the great men of the earth - A
circumstance which was in itself indifferent, and yet led them into
pride, luxury, and numberless other sins.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xix-p17">24. And in her was found the blood of the prophets and
saints - The same angel speaks still, yet he does not say "in thee," but
in her, now so sunk as not to hear these last words. And of all that had
been slain - Even before she was built. See <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 35" id="i.xxviii.xix-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|23|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.35">Matt. xxiii, 35</scripRef>. There is no city under the sun which has so clear a title
to catholic blood-guiltiness as Rome. The guilt of the blood shed under
the heathen emperors has not been removed under the Popes, but hugely
multiplied. Nor is Rome accountable only for that which hath been shed
in the city, but for that shed in all the earth. For at Rome under the
Pope, as well as under the heathen emperors, were the bloody orders and
edicts given: and wherever the blood of holy men was shed, there were
the grand rejoicings for it. And what immense quantities of blood have
been shed by her agents! Charles IX., of France, in his letter to
Gregory XIII., boasts, that in and not long after the massacre of Paris,
he had destroyed seventy thousand Hugonots. Some have computed, that,
from the year 1518, to 1548, fifteen millions of Protestants have
perished by the Inquisition. This may be overcharged; but certainly the
number of them in those thirty years, as well as since, is almost
incredible. To these we may add innumerable martyrs, in ancient, middle,
and late ages, in Bohemia, Germany, Holland, France, England, Ireland,
and many other parts of Europe, Afric, and Asia.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="30.20%" prev="i.xxviii.xix" next="i.xxviii.xxi" id="i.xxviii.xx">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xx-p0.1">XIX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XIX" id="i.xxviii.xx-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.19" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p1">1. I heard a loud voice of a great multitude - Whose blood
the great whore had shed. Saying, Hallelujah - This Hebrew word
signifies, Praise ye Jah, or Him that is. God named himself to Moses,
EHEIEH, that is, I will be, <scripRef passage="Exod. iii. 14" id="i.xxviii.xx-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|3|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3.14">Exod. iii,
14</scripRef>; and at the same time, "Jehovah," that is, "He that is, and
was, and is to come:" during the trumpet of the seventh angel, he is
styled, "He that is and was," chap. xvi, 5; and not "He that is to
come;" because his long-expected coming is under this trumpet actually
present. At length he is styled, "Jah," "He that is;" the past together
with the future being swallowed up in the present, the former things
being no more mentioned, for the greatness of those that now are. This
title is of all others the most peculiar to the everlasting God. The
salvation - Is opposed to the destruction which the great whore had
brought upon the earth. His power and glory - Appear from the judgment
executed on her, and from the setting up his kingdom to endure through
all ages.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p2">2. For true and righteous are his judgments - Thus is the
cry of the souls under the altar changed into a song of praise.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p3">4. And the four and twenty elders, and the four living
creatures felt down - The living creatures are nearer the throne than
the elders. Accordingly they are mentioned before them, with the praise
they render to God, chap. iv, 9, 10; v, 8, 14; inasmuch as there the
praise moves from the center to the circumference. But here, when God's
judgments are fulfilled, it moves back from the circumference to the
center. Here, therefore, the four and twenty elders are named before the
living creatures.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p4">5. And a voice came forth from the throne - Probably from
the four living creatures, saying, Praise our God - The occasion and
matter of this song of praise follow immediately after, verses 6,
&amp;c.; God was praised before, for his judgment of the great whore,
verses 1-4. chap. xix, 1-4 Now for that which follows it: for that the
Lord God, the Almighty, takes the kingdom to himself, and avenges
himself on the rest of his enemies. Were all these inhabitants of heaven
mistaken? If not, there is real, yea, and terrible anger in God.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p5">6. And I heard the voice of a great multitude. So all his
servants did praise him. The Almighty reigneth - More eminently and
gloriously than ever before.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p6">7. The marriage of the Lamb is come - Is near at hand, to
be solemnized speedily. What this implies, none of "the spirits of just
men," even in paradise, yet know. O what things are those which are yet
behind! And what purity of heart should there be, to meditate upon them!
And his wife hath made herself ready - Even upon earth; but in a far
higher sense, in that world. After a time allowed for this, the new
Jerusalem comes down, both made ready and adorned, chap. xxi, 2.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p7">8. And it is given to her - By God. The bride is all holy
men, the whole invisible church. To be arrayed in fine linen, white and
clean - This is an emblem of the righteousness of the saints - Both of
their justification and sanctification.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p8">9. And he - The angel, saith to me, Write - St. John seems
to have been so amazed at these glorious sights, that he needeth to be
reminded of this. Happy are they who are invited to the marriage supper
of the Lamb - Called to glory. And he saith - After a little pause.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p9">10. And I fell before his feet to worship him - It seems,
mistaking him for the angel of the covenant. But he saith, See thou do
it not - In the original, it is only, See not, with a beautiful
abruptness. To pray to or worship the highest creature is flat idolatry.
I am thy fellowservant and of thy brethren that have the testimony of
Jesus - I am now employed as your fellowservant, to testify of the Lord
Jesus, by the same Spirit which inspired the prophets of old.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p10">11. And I saw the heaven opened - This is a new and
peculiar opening of it, in order to show the magnificent expedition of
Christ and his attendants, against his great adversary. And behold a
white horse - Many little regarded Christ, when he came meek, "riding
upon an ass;" but what will they say, when he goes forth upon his white
horse, with the sword of his mouth? White - Such as generals use in
solemn triumph. And he that sitteth on him, called Faithful - In
performing all his promises. And True - In executing all his
threatenings. And in righteousness - With the utmost justice. He judgeth
and maketh war - Often the sentence and execution go together.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p11">12. And his eyes are a flame of fire - They were said to be
as or like a flame of fire, before, chap. i, 14; an emblem of his
omniscience. And upon his head are many diadems - For he is king of all
nations. And he hath a name written, which none knoweth but himself - As
God he is incomprehensible to every creature.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p12">13. And he is clothed in a vesture dipped in blood - The
blood of the enemies he hath already conquered. <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxiii. 1" id="i.xxviii.xx-p12.1" parsed="|Isa|63|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.63.1">Isaiah lxiii, 1</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p13">15. And he shall rule them - Who are not slain by his
sword. With a rod of iron - That is, if they will not submit to his
golden scepter. And he treadeth the wine press of the wrath of God -
That is, he executes his judgments on the ungodly. This ruler of the
nations was born (or appeared as such) immediately after the seventh
angel began to sound. He now appears, not as a child, but as a
victorious warrior. The nations have long ago felt his "iron rod,"
partly while the heathen Romans, after their savage persecution of the
Christians, themselves groaned under numberless plagues and calamities,
by his righteous vengeance; partly, while other heathens have been
broken in pieces by those who bore the Christian name. For although the
cruelty, for example, of the Spaniards in America, was unrighteous and
detestable, yet did God therein execute his righteous judgment on the
unbelieving nations; but they shall experience his iron rod as they
never did yet, and then will they all return to their rightful Lord.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p14">16. And he hath on his vesture and on his thigh - That is,
on the part of his vesture which is upon his thigh. A name written - It
was usual of old, for great personages in the eastern countries, to have
magnificent titles affixed to their garments.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p15">17. Gather yourselves together to the great supper of God -
As to a great feast, which the vengeance of God will soon provide; a
strongly figurative expression, (taken from <scripRef passage="Ezek. xxxix. 17" id="i.xxviii.xx-p15.1" parsed="|Ezek|39|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.39.17">Ezek. xxxix, 17</scripRef>,) denoting the vastness of the ensuing slaughter.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p16">19. And I saw the kings of the earth - The ten kings
mentioned chap. xvii, 12; who had now drawn the other kings of the earth
to them, whether Popish, Mahometan, or pagan. Gathered together to make
war with him that sat upon the horse - All beings, good and evil,
visible and invisible, will be concerned in this grand contest. See <scripRef passage="Zech. xiv. 1" id="i.xxviii.xx-p16.1" parsed="|Zech|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.14.1">Zech. xiv, 1</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p17">20. The false prophet, who had wrought the miracles before
him - And therefore shared in his punishment; these two ungodly men were
cast alive - Without undergoing bodily death. Into the lake of fire -
And that before the devil himself, chap. xx, 10. Here is the last of the
beast. After several repeated strokes of omnipotence, he is gone alive
into hell. There were two that went alive into heaven; perhaps there are
two that go alive into hell. It may be, Enoch and Elijah entered at once
into glory, without first waiting in paradise; the beast and the false
prophet plunge at once into the extremest degree of torment, without
being reserved in chains of darkness till the judgment of the great day.
Surely, none but the beast of Rome would have hardened himself thus
against the God he pretended to adore, or refused to have repented under
such dreadful, repeated visitations! Well is he styled a beast, from his
carnal and vile affections; a wild beast, from his savage and cruel
spirit! The rest were slain - A like difference is afterwards made
between the devil, and Gog and Magog, chap. xx, 9, 10.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xx-p18">21. Here is a most magnificent description of the overthrow
of the beast and his adherents. It has, in particular, one exquisite
beauty; that, after exhibiting the two opposite armies, and all the
apparatus for a battle, verses 11-19; chap. xix, 11-19 then follows
immediately, verse 20, xix, 20 the account of the victory, without one
word of an engagement or fighting. Here is the most exact propriety; for
what struggle can there be between omnipotence, and the power of all the
creation united against it! Every description must have fallen short of
this admirable silence.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="30.34%" prev="i.xxviii.xx" next="i.xxviii.xxii" id="i.xxviii.xxi">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xxi-p0.1">XX</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XX" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.20" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p1">1. And I saw an angel decending out of heaven - Coming down
with a commission from God. Jesus Christ himself overthrew the beast:
the proud dragon shall be bound by an angel; even as he and his angels
were cast out of heaven by Michael and his angels. Having the key of the
bottomless pit - Mentioned before, chap. ix, 1. And a great chain in his
hand - The angel of the bottomless pit was shut up therein before the
beginning of the first woe. But it is now first that Satan, after he had
occasioned the third woe, is both chained and shut up.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p2">2. And he laid hold on the dragon - With whom undoubtedly
his angels were now cast into the bottomless pit, as well as finally
"into everlasting fire," <scripRef passage="Matt. xxv. 41" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|25|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.25.41">Matt. xxv,
41</scripRef>. And bound him a thousand years - That these thousand do not
precede, or run parallel with, but wholly follow, the times of the
beast, may manifestly appear,</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p3">1. From the series of the whole book,
representing one continued chain of events.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p4">2. From the circumstances which precede. The
woman's bringing forth is followed by the casting of the dragon out of
heaven to the earth. With this is connected the third woe, whereby the
dragon through, and with, the beast, rages horribly. At the conclusion
of the third woe the beast is overthrown and cast into "the lake of
fire." At the same time the other grand enemy, the dragon, shall be
bound and shut up.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p5">3. These thousand years bring a new, full,
and lasting immunity from all outward and inward evils, the authors of
which are now removed, and an affluence of all blessings. But such time
the church has never yet seen. Therefore it is still to come.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p6">4. These thousand years are followed by the
last times of the world, the letting loose of Satan, who gathers
together Gog and Magog, and is thrown to the beast and false prophet "in
the lake of fire." Now Satan's accusing the saints in heaven, his rage
on earth, his imprisonment in the abyss, his seducing Gog and Magog, and
being cast into the lake of fire, evidently succeed each other.</p>

<p class="List3" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p7">5. What occurs from chap. xx, 11 - chap.
xxii, 5, manifestly follows the things related in the nineteenth
chapter. The thousand years came between; whereas if they were past,
neither the beginning nor the end of them would fall within this period.
In a short time those who assert that they are now at hand will appear
to have spoken the truth. Meantime let every man consider what kind of
happiness he expects therein. The danger does not lie in maintaining
that the thousand years are yet to come; but in interpreting them,
whether past or to come, in a gross and carnal sense. The doctrine of
the Son of God is a mystery. So is his cross; and so is his glory. In
all these he is a sign that is spoken against. Happy they who believe
and confess him in all!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p8">3. And set a seal upon him - How far these expressions are
to be taken literally, how far figuratively only, who can tell? That he
might deceive the nations no more - One benefit only is here expressed,
as resulting from the confinement of Satan. But how many and great
blessings are implied! For the grand enemy being removed, the kingdom of
God holds on its uninterrupted course among the nations; and the great
mystery of God, so long foretold, is at length fulfilled; namely, when
the beast is destroyed and Satan bound. This fulfilment approaches
nearer and nearer; and contains things of the utmost importance, the
knowledge of which becomes every day more distinct and easy. In the mean
time it is highly necessary to guard against the present rage and
subtilty of the devil. Quickly he will be bound: when he is loosed
again, the martyrs will live and reign with Christ. Then follow his
coming in glory, the new heaven, new earth, and new Jerusalem. The
bottomless pit is properly the devil's prison; afterwards he is cast
into the lake of fire. He can deceive the nations no more till the
"thousand years," mentioned before, verse 2, chap. xx, 2 are fulfilled.
Then he must be loosed - So does the mysterious wisdom of God permit.
For a small time - Small comparatively: though upon the whole it cannot
be very short, because the things to be transacted therein, verses 8, 9,
chap. xx, 8, 9 must take up a considerable space. We are very shortly to
expect, one after another, the calamities occasioned by the second
beast, the harvest and the vintage, the pouring out of the phials, the
judgment of Babylon, the last raging of the beast and his destruction,
the imprisonment of Satan. How great things these! and how short the
time! What is needful for us? Wisdom, patience, faithfulness,
watchfulness. It is no time to settle upon our lees. This is not, if it
be rightly understood, an acceptable message to the wise, the mighty,
the honourable, of this world. Yet that which is to be done, shall be
done: there is no counsel against the Lord.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p9">4. And I saw thrones - Such as are promised the apostles, <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 28" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|19|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.28">Matt. xix, 28</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Luke xxii. 30" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p9.2" parsed="|Luke|22|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.22.30">Luke xxii, 30</scripRef>. And they - Namely, the saints, whom St. John saw at the
same time, <scripRef passage="Dan. vii. 22" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p9.3" parsed="|Dan|7|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.7.22">Dan. vii, 22</scripRef>, sat upon them; and Judgment was given to them. <scripRef passage="1 Cor. vi. 2" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p9.4" parsed="|1Cor|6|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.6.2">1 Cor.
vi, 2</scripRef>. Who, and how many, these are, is not said. But they are
distinguished from the souls, or persons, mentioned immediately after;
and from the saints already raised. And I saw the souls of those who had
been beheaded - With the axe: so the original word signifies. One kind
of death, which was particularly inflicted at Rome, is mentioned for
all. For the testimony of Jesus, and for the word of God - The martyrs
were sometimes killed for the word of God in general; sometimes
particularly for the testimony of Jesus: the one, while they refused to
worship idols; the other, while they confessed the name of Christ. And
those who had not worshipped the wild beast, nor his image - These seem
to be a company distinct from those who appeared, chap. xv, 2. Those
overcame, probably, in such contests as these had not. Before the number
of the beast was expired, the people were compelled to worship him, by
the most dreadful violence. But when the beast "was not," they were only
seduced into it by the craft of the false prophet. And they lived -
Their souls and bodies being re-united. And reigned with Christ - Not on
earth, but in heaven. The "reigning on earth" mentioned, chap. xi, 15,
is quite different from this. A thousand years - It must be observed,
that two distinct thousand years are mentioned throughout this whole
passage. Each is mentioned thrice; the thousand wherein Satan is bound,
verses 2, 3, 7; chap. xx, 2, 3, 7, the thousand wherein the saints shall
reign, verses 4-6. chap. xx, 4-6 The former end before the end of the
world; the latter reach to the general resurrection. So that the
beginning and end of the former thousand is before the beginning and end
of the latter. Therefore as in the second verse, chap. xx, 2 at the
first mention of the former; so in the fourth verse, chap. xx, 2 at the
first mention of the latter, it is only said, a thousand years; in the
other places, "the thousand," verses 3, 5, 7, chap. xx, 3, 5, 7 that is,
the thousand mentioned before. During the former, the promises
concerning the flourishing state of the church, chap. x, 7, shall be
fulfilled; during the latter, while the saints reign with Christ in
heaven, men on earth will be careless and secure.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p10">5. The rest of the dead lived not till the thousand years -
Mentioned, verse 4. Were ended - The thousand years during which Satan
is bound both begin and end much sooner. The small time, and the second
thousand years, begin at the same point, immediately after the first
thousand. But neither the beginning of the first nor of the second
thousand will be known to the men upon earth, as both the imprisonment
of Satan and his loosing are transacted in the invisible world. By
observing these two distinct thousand years, many difficulties are
avoided. There is room enough for the fulfilling of all the prophecies,
and those which before seemed to clash are reconciled; particularly
those which speak, on the one hand, of a most flourishing state of the
church as yet to come; and, on the other, of the fatal security of men
in the last days of the world.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p11">6. They shall be priests of God and of Christ - Therefore
Christ is God. And shall reign with him - With Christ, a thousand
years.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p12">7. And when the former thousand years are fulfilled, Satan
shall be loosed out of his prison - At the same time that the first
resurrection begins. There is a great resemblance between this passage
and chap. xii, 12. At the casting out of the dragon, there was joy in
heaven, but there was woe upon earth: so at the loosing of Satan, the
saints begin to reign with Christ; but the nations on earth are
deceived.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p13">8. And shall go forth to deceive the nations in the four
corners of the earth - (That is, in all the earth)-the more diligently,
as he hath been so long restrained, and knoweth he hath but a small
time. Gog and Magog - Magog, the second son of Japhet, is the father of
the innumerable northern nations toward the east. The prince of these
nations, of which the bulk of that army will consist, is termed Gog by
Ezekiel also, <scripRef passage="Ezek. xxxviii. 2" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p13.1" parsed="|Ezek|38|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.38.2">Ezek. xxxviii,
2</scripRef>. Both Gog and Magog signify high or lifted up; a name well
suiting both the prince and people. When that fierce leader of many
nations shall appear, then will his own name be known. To gather them -
Both Gog and his armies. Of Gog, little more is said, as being soon
mingled with the rest in the common slaughter. The Revelation speaks of
this the more briefly, because it had been so particularly described by
Ezekiel. Whose number is as the sand of the sea - Immensely numerous: a
proverbial expression.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p14">9. And they went up on the breadth of the earth, or the
land - Filling the whole breadth of it. And surrounded the camp of the
saints - Perhaps the gentile church, dwelling round about Jerusalem. And
the beloved city - So termed, likewise, <scripRef passage="Ecclesiasticus xxiv. 11" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p14.1" parsed="|Sir|24|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Sir.24.11">Ecclesiasticus xxiv. 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p15">10. And they - All these. Shall be tormented day and night
- That is, without any intermission. Strictly speaking, there is only
night there: no day, no sun, no hope!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p16">11. And I saw - A representation of that great day of the
Lord. A great white throne - How great, who can say? White with the
glory of God, of him that sat upon it, - Jesus Christ. The apostle does
not attempt to describe him here; only adds that circumstance, far above
all description, From whose face the earth and the heaven fled away -
Probably both the aerial and the starry heaven; which "shall pass away
with a great noise." And there was found no place for them - But they
were wholly dissolved, the very "elements melting with fervent heat." It
is not said, they were thrown into great commotions, but they fled
entirely away; not, they started from their foundations, but they " fell
into dissolution;" not, they removed to a distant place, but there was
found no place for them; they ceased to exist; they were no more. And
all this, not at the strict command of the Lord Jesus; not at his awful
presence, or before his fiery indignation; but at the bare presence of
his Majesty, sitting with severe but adorable dignity on his throne.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p17">12. And I saw the dead, great and small - Of every age and
condition. This includes, also, those who undergo a change equivalent to
death, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. xv. 51" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p17.1" parsed="|1Cor|15|51|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.15.51">1 Cor. xv, 51</scripRef>. And the books - Human Judges have their books written with
pen and ink: how different is the nature of these books! Were opened - O
how many hidden things will then come to light; and how many will have
quite another appearance than they had before in the sight of men! With
the book of God's omniscience, that of conscience will then exactly
tally. The book of natural law, as well as of revealed, will then also
be displayed. It is not said, The books will be read: the light of that
day will make them visible to all. Then, particularly, shall every man
know himself, and that with the last exactness This will be the first
true, full, impartial, universal history. And another book - Wherein are
enrolled all that are accepted through the Beloved; all who lived and
died in the faith that worketh by love. Which is the book of life, was
opened - What manner of expectation will then be, with regard to the
issue of the whole! <scripRef passage="Mal. iii. 16" id="i.xxviii.xxi-p17.2" parsed="|Mal|3|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mal.3.16">Mal. iii, 16</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p18">13. Death and hades gave up the dead that were in them -
Death gave up all the bodies of men; and hades, the receptacle of
separate souls, gave them up, to be re-united to their bodies.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxi-p19">14. And death and hades were cast into the lake of fire -
That is, were abolished forever; for neither the righteous nor the
wicked were to die any more: their souls and bodies were no more to be
separated. Consequently, neither death nor hades could any more have a
being.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="30.57%" prev="i.xxviii.xxi" next="i.xxviii.xxiii" id="i.xxviii.xxii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xxii-p0.1">XXI</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XXI" id="i.xxviii.xxii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.21" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p1">1. And I saw - So it runs, chap. xix, 11, xx, 1, 4, 11, in
a succession. All these several representations follow one another in
order: so the vision reaches into eternity. A new heaven and a new earth
- After the resurrection and general judgment. St. John is not now
describing a flourishing state of the church, but a new and eternal
state of all things. For the first heaven and the first earth - Not only
the lowest part of heaven, not only the solar system, but the whole
ethereal heaven, with all its host, whether of planets or fixed stars, <scripRef passage="Isai xxxiv. 4" id="i.xxviii.xxii-p1.1" parsed="|Isa|34|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.34.4">Isai xxxiv, 4</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiv. 29" id="i.xxviii.xxii-p1.2" parsed="|Matt|24|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.24.29">Matt. xxiv, 29</scripRef>. All the former things will be done away, that all may
become new, verses 4, 5, <scripRef passage="2 Pet. iii. 10, 12" id="i.xxviii.xxii-p1.3" parsed="|2Pet|3|10|0|0;|2Pet|3|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.3.10 Bible:2Pet.3.12">2 Pet. iii, 10, 12</scripRef>. Are passed away - But in the fourth verse it is said, "are
gone away." There the stronger word is used; for death, mourning, and
sorrow go away all together: the former heaven and earth only pass away,
giving place to the new heaven and the new earth.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p2">2. And I saw the holy city - The new heaven, the new earth,
and the new Jerusalem, are closely connected. This city is wholly new,
belonging not to this world, not to the millennium, but to eternity.
This appears from the series of the vision, the magnificence of the
description, and the opposition of this city to the second death, chap.
xx, 11, 12; xxi, 1, 2, 5, 8, 9; xxii, 5. Coming down - In the very act
of descending.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p3">3. They shall be his people, and God himself shall be with
them, and be their God - So shall the covenant between God and his
people be executed in the most glorious manner.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p4">4. And death shall be no more - This is a full proof that
this whole description belongs not to time, but eternity. Neither shall
sorrow, or crying, or pain, be any more: for the former things are gone
away - Under the former heaven, and upon the former earth, there was
death and sorrow, crying and pain; all which occasioned many tears: but
now pain and sorrow are fled away, and the saints have everlasting life
and joy.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p5">5. And he that sat upon the throne said - Not to St. John
only. From the first mention of "him that sat upon the throne," chap.
iv, 2, this is the first speech which is expressly ascribed to him. And
he - The angel. Saith to me Write - As follows. These sayings are
faithful and true - This includes all that went before. The apostle
seems again to have ceased writing, being overcome with ecstasy at the
voice of him that spake.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p6">6. And he - That sat upon the throne. Said to me, It is
done - All that the prophets had spoken; all that was spoken, chap. iv,
1. We read this expression twice in this prophecy: first, chap. xvi, 17,
at the fulfilling of the wrath of God; and here, at the making all
things new. I am the Alpha and the Omega, the beginning and the end -
The latter explains the former: the Everlasting. I will give to him that
thirsteth - The Lamb saith the same, chap. xxii, 17.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p7">7. He that overcometh - Which is more than, "he that
thirsteth." Shall inherit these things - Which I have made new. I will
be his God, and he shall be my son - Both in the Hebrew and Greek
language, in which the scriptures were written, what we translate shall
and will are one and the same word. The only difference consists in an
English translation, or in the want of knowledge in him that interprets
what he does not understand.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p8">8. But the fearful and unbelieving - Who, through want of
courage and faith, do not overcome. And abominable - That is, sodomites.
And whoremongers, and sorcerers, and idolaters - These three sins
generally went together; their part is in the lake.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p9">9. And there came one of the seven angels that had the
seven phials - Whereby room had been made for the kingdom of God.
Saying, Come, I will show thee the bride - The same angel had before
showed him Babylon, chap. xvii, 1, which is directly opposed to the new
Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p10">10. And he carried me away in the spirit - The same
expression as before, chap. xvii, 3. And showed me the holy city
Jerusalem - The old city is now forgotten, so that this is no longer
termed the new, but absolutely Jerusalem. O how did St. John long to
enter in! but the time was not yet come. Ezekiel also describes "the
holy city," and what pertains thereto, xl.-xlviii. <scripRef passage="Ezek. xl. 1" id="i.xxviii.xxii-p10.1" parsed="|Ezek|40|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.40.1">Ezek. xl, 1</scripRef>-<scripRef passage="Ezek. xlviii. 35" id="i.xxviii.xxii-p10.2" parsed="|Ezek|48|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.48.35">Ezek. xlviii, 35</scripRef> but a city quite different from the old Jerusalem, as it was
either before or after the Babylonish captivity. The descriptions of the
prophet and of the apostle agree in many particulars; but in many more
they differ. Ezekiel expressly describes the temple, and the worship of
God therein, closely alluding to the Levitical service. But St. John saw
no temple, and describes the city far more large, glorious, and heavenly
than the prophet. Yet that which he describes is the same city; but as
it subsisted soon after the destruction of the beast. This being
observed, both the prophecies agree together and one may explain the
other.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p11">11. Having the glory of God - For her light, verse 23, ver.
23, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 1, 2" id="i.xxviii.xxii-p11.1" parsed="|Isa|40|1|40|2" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.1-Isa.40.2">Isaiah xl, 1, 2</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Zech. ii. 5" id="i.xxviii.xxii-p11.2" parsed="|Zech|2|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.2.5">Zech. ii, 5</scripRef>. Her window - There was only one, which ran all round the
city. The light did not come in from without through this for the glory
of God is within the city. But it shines out from within to a great
distance, verses 23, 24. chap. xxi, 23, 24</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p12">12. Twelve angels - Still waiting upon the heirs of
salvation.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p13">14. And the wall of the city had twelve foundations, and on
them the names of the twelve apostles of the Lamb - Figuratively showing
that the inhabitants of the city had built only on that faith which the
apostles once delivered to the saints.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p14">15. And he measured the city, twelve thousand furlongs -
Not in circumference, but on each of the four sides. Jerusalem was
thirtythree furlongs in circumference; Alexandria thirty in length, ten
in breadth. Nineveh is reported to have been four hundred furlongs
round; Babylon four hundred and eighty. But what inconsiderable villages
were all these compared to the new Jerusalem! By this measure is
understood the greatness of the city, with the exact order and just
proportion of every part of it; to show, figuratively, that this city
was prepared for a great number of inhabitants, how small soever the
number of real Christians may sometimes appear to be; and that
everything relating to the happiness of that state was prepared with the
greatest order and exactness. The city is twelve thousand furlongs high;
the wall, an hundred and forty-four reeds. This is exactly the same
height, only expressed in a different manner. The twelve thousand
furlongs, being spoken absolutely, without any explanation, are common,
human furlongs: the hundred forty-four reeds are not of common human
length, but of angelic, abundantly larger than human. It is said, the
measure of a man that is, of an angel because St. John saw the measuring
angel in an human shape. The reed therefore was as great as was the
stature of that human form in which the angel appeared. In treating of
all these things a deep reverence is necessary; and so is a measure of
spiritual wisdom; that we may neither understand them too literally and
grossly, nor go too far from the natural force of the words. The gold,
the pearls, the precious stones, the walls, foundations, gates, are
undoubtedly figurative expressions; seeing the city itself is in glory,
and the inhabitants of it have spiritual bodies: yet these spiritual
bodies are also real bodies, and the city is an abode distinct from its
inhabitants, and proportioned to them who take up a finite and a
determinate space. The measures, therefore, above mentioned are real and
determinate.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p15">18. And the building of the wall was jasper - That is, the
wall was built of jasper. And the city - The houses, was of pure
gold.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p16">19. And the foundations were adorned with precious stones -
That is, beautifully made of them. The precious stones on the high
priest's breastplate of judgment were a proper emblem to express the
happiness of God's church in his presence with them, and in the blessing
of his protection. The like ornaments on the foundations of the walls of
this city may express the perfect glory and happiness of all the
inhabitants of it from the most glorious presence and protection of God.
Each precious stone was not the ornament of the foundation, but the
foundation itself. The colours of these are remarkably mixed. A jasper
is of the colour of white marble, with a light shade of green and of
red; a sapphire is of a sky-blue, speckled with gold; a chalcedony, or
carbuncle, of the colour of red-hot iron; an emerald, of a grass
green.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p17">20. A sardonyx is red streaked with white; a sardius, of a
deep red; a chrysolite, of a deep yellow; a beryl, sea-green; a topaz,
pale yellow; a chrysoprase is greenish and transparent, with gold
specks; a jacinth, of a red purple; an amethyst, violet purple.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p18">22. The Lord God and the Lamb are the temple of it - He
fills the new heaven and the new earth. He surrounds the city and
sanctifies it, and all that are therein. He is "all in all."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p19">23. The glory of God - Infinitely brighter than the shining
of the sun.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p20">24. And the nations - The whole verse is taken from <scripRef passage="Isaiah lx. 3" id="i.xxviii.xxii-p20.1" parsed="|Isa|60|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.60.3">Isaiah lx, 3</scripRef>. Shall walk by the light thereof - Which throws itself
outward from the city far and near. And the kings of the earth - Those
of them who have a part there. Bring their glory into it - Not their old
glory, which is now abolished; but such as becomes the new earth, and
receives an immense addition by their entrance into the city.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p21">26. And they shall bring the glory of the nations into it -
It seems, a select part of each nation; that is, all which can
contribute to make this city honourable and glorious shall be found in
it; as if all that was rich and precious throughout the world was
brought into one city.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxii-p22">27. Common - That is. unholy. But those who are written in
the Lamb's book of life - True, holy, persevering believers. This
blessedness is enjoyed by those only; and, as such, they are registered
among them who are to inherit eternal life.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="30.74%" prev="i.xxviii.xxii" next="ii" id="i.xxviii.xxiii">
<h3 id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p0.1">XXII</h3> <scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Rev. XXII" id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p0.2" parsed="|Rev|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.22" /> 

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p1">1. And he showed me a river of the water of life - The ever
fresh and fruitful effluence of the Holy Ghost. See <scripRef passage="Ezek. xlvii. 1-12" id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p1.1" parsed="|Ezek|47|1|47|12" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.47.1-Ezek.47.12">Ezek. xlvii, 1-12</scripRef>; where also the trees are mentioned which "bear fruit every
month," that is, perpetually. Proceeding out of the throne of God, and
of the Lamb - "All that the Father hath," saith the Son of God, "is
mine;" even the throne of his glory.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p2">2. In the midst of the street - Here is the paradise of
God, mentioned, chap. ii, 7. Is the tree of life - Not one tree only,
but many. Every month - That is, in inexpressible abundance. The
variety, likewise, as well as the abundance of the fruits of the Spirit,
may be intimated thereby. And the leaves are for the healing of the
nations - For the continuing their health, not the restoring it; for no
sickness is there.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p3">3. And there shall be no more curse - But pure life and
blessing; every effect of the displeasure of God for sin being now
totally removed. But the throne of God and the Lamb shall be in it -
That is, the glorious presence and reign of God. And his servants - The
highest honour in the universe. Shalt worship him - The noblest
employment.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p4">4. And shall see his face - Which was not granted to Moses.
They shall have the nearest access to, and thence the highest
resemblance of, him. This is the highest expression in the language of
scripture to denote the most perfect happiness of the heavenly state, <scripRef passage="1 John iii. 2" id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p4.1" parsed="|1John|3|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.3.2">1 John iii, 2</scripRef>. And his name shall be on their foreheads - Each of them
shall be openly acknowledged as God's own property, and his glorious
nature most visibly shine forth in them. And they shall reign - But who
are the subjects of these kings? The other inhabitants of the new earth.
For there must needs be an everlasting difference between those who when
on earth excelled in virtue, and those comparatively slothful and
unprofitable servants, who were just saved as by fire. The kingdom of
God is taken by force; but the prize is worth all the labour. Whatever
of high, lovely, or excellent is in all the monarchies of the earth is
all together not a grain of dust, compared to the glory of the children
of God. God "is not ashamed to be called their God, for whom he hath
prepared this city." But who shall come up into his holy place? "They
who keep his commandments," verse 14. ver. 14</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p5">5. And they shall reign forever and ever - What
encouragement is this to the patience and faithfulness of the saints,
that, whatever their sufferings are, they will work out for them "an
eternal weight of glory!" Thus ends the doctrine of this Revelation, in
the everlasting happiness of all the faithful. The mysterious ways of
Providence are cleared up, and all things issue in an eternal Sabbath,
an everlasting state of perfect peace and happiness, reserved for all
who endure to the end.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p6">6. And he said to me - Here begins the conclusion of the
book, exactly agreeing with the introduction, (particularly verses 6, 7,
10, ver. 6, 7, 10 with chap. i, 1, 3,) chap. i, 1, 3 and giving light to
the whole book, as this book does to the whole scripture. These sayings
are faithful and true - All the things which you have heard and seen
shall be faithfully accomplished in their order, and are infallibly
true. The Lord, the God of the holy prophets - Who inspired and
authorised them of old. Hath now sent me his angel, to show his servants
- By thee. The things which must be done shortly - Which will begin to
be performed immediately.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p7">7. Behold, I come quickly - Saith our Lord himself, to
accomplish these things. Happy is he that keepeth - Without adding or
diminishing, verses 18, 19, ver. 18, 19 the words of this book.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p8">8. I fell down to worship at the feet of the angel - The
very same words which occur, chap. xix, 10. The reproof of the angel,
likewise, See thou do it not, for I am thy fellowservant, is expressed
in the very same terms as before. May it not be the very same incident
which is here related again? Is not this far more probable, than that
the apostle would commit a fault again, of which he had been so solemnly
warned before?</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p9">9. See thou do it not - The expression in the original is
short and elliptical, as is usual in showing vehement aversion.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p10">10. And he saith to me - After a little pause. Seal not the
sayings of this book - Conceal them not, like the things that are sealed
up. The time is nigh - Wherein they shall begin to take place.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p11">11. He that is unrighteous - As if he had said, The final
judgment is at hand; after which the condition of all mankind will admit
of no change forever. Unrighteous - Unjustified. Filthy - Unsanctified,
unholy.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p12">12. I - Jesus Christ. Come quickly - To judge the world.
And my reward is with me - The rewards which I assign both to the
righteous and the wicked are given at my coming. To give to every man
according as his work - His whole inward and outward behaviour shall
be.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p13">13. I am the Alpha and the Omega, the first and the last -
Who exist from everlasting to everlasting. How clear, incontestable a
proof, does our Lord here give of his divine glory!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p14">14. Happy are they that do his commandments - His, who
saith, I come - He speaks of himself. That they may have right - Through
his gracious covenant. To the tree of life - To all the blessings
signified by it. When Adam broke his commandment, he was driven from the
tree of life. They who keep his commandments "shall eat thereof."</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p15">15. Without are dogs - The sentence in the original is
abrupt, as expressing abhorrence. The gates are ever open; but not for
dogs; fierce and rapacious men.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p16">16. I Jesus have sent my angel to testify these things -
Primarily. To you - The seven angels of the churches; then to those
churches - and afterwards to all other churches in succeeding ages. I -
as God. Am the root - And source of David's family and kingdom; as man,
an descended from his loins. "I am the star out of Jacob," <scripRef passage="Num. xxiv. 17" id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p16.1" parsed="|Num|24|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.24.17">Num. xxiv, 17</scripRef>; like the bright morning star, who put an end to the night
of ignorance, sin, and sorrow, and usher in an eternal day of light,
purity, and joy.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p17">17. The Spirit and the bride - The Spirit of adoption in
the bride, in the heart of every true believer. Say - With earnest
desire and expectation. Come - And accomplish all the words of this
prophecy. And let him that thirsteth, come - Here they also who are
farther off are invited. And whosoever will, let him take the water of
life - He may partake of my spiritual and unspeakable blessings, as
freely as he makes use of the most common refreshments; as freely as he
drinks of the running stream.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p18">18, 19. I testify to every one, &amp;c. - From the fulness
of his heart, the apostle utters this testimony, this weighty
admonition, not only to the churches of Asia, but to all who should ever
hear this book. He that adds, all the plagues shall be added to him; he
that takes from it, all the blessings shall be taken from him; and,
doubtless, this guilt is incurred by all those who lay hindrances in the
way of the faithful, which prevent them from hearing their Lord's "I
come," and answering, "Come, Lord Jesus." This may likewise be
considered as an awful sanction, given to the whole New Testament; in
like manner as Moses guarded the law, <scripRef passage="Deut. iv. 2" id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p18.1" parsed="|Deut|4|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.4.2">Deut. iv, 2</scripRef>, and <scripRef passage="Deut. xii. 32" id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p18.2" parsed="|Deut|12|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.12.32">Deut. xii, 32</scripRef>; and as God himself did, <scripRef passage="Mal. iv. 4" id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p18.3" parsed="|Mal|4|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mal.4.4">Mal. iv, 4</scripRef>, in closing the canon of the Old Testament.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p19">20. He that testifieth these things - Even all that is
contained in this book. Saith - For the encouragement of the church in
all her afflictions. Yea - Answering the call of the Spirit and the
bride. I come quickly - To destroy all her enemies, and establish her in
a state of perfect and everlasting happiness. The apostle expresses his
earnest desire and hope of this, by answering, Amen. Come, Lord
Jesus!</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p20">21. The grace - The free love. Of the Lord Jesus - And all
its fruits. Be with all - Who thus long for his appearing! It may be
proper to subjoin here a short view of the whole contents of this book.
In the year of the world, 3940. Jesus Christ is born, three years before
the common computation. In that which is vulgarly called, the thirtieth
year of our Lord, Jesus Christ dies; rises; ascends. Year (A.D.) Event
As Described In Revelation Chapter/Verse 96 The Revelation is given; the
coming of our Lord is declared to the seven churches in Asia, and their
angels, <scripRef passage="Rev i., ii., iii." id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p20.1">Rev i., ii., iii.</scripRef> 97, 98 The seven seals are opened, and under
the fifth the chronos is declared, iv.-vi. Seven trumpets are given to
the seven angels, vii. viii. Century, 2d, 3d, 4th, 5th, the trumpet of
the 1st, 2d, 3d, 4th angel, viii.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p21">510-589 The first woe, \...............</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p22">589-634 The interval after the first woe} ix......</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p23">634-840 The second woe, /...............</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p24">800 The beginning of the non-chronos \............... many
kings, } ix., x.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p25">840-947 The interval after the second woe,
/...............</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p26">847-1521 The twelve hundred and sixty days of the woman,
after she hath brought forth the man child, C xii. 6</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p27">947-1836 The third woe, 12</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p28">1058-1836 The time, times, and half a time, and
\................... within that period, the beast, his forty}to xiii.
5 two months, his number 666, /...................</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p29">1209 War with the saints: the end of the chronos, 7</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p30">1614 An everlasting gospel promulged, xiv. 6</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p31">1810 The end of the forty-two months of the beast; after
which, and the pouring out of the phials, he is not, and Babylon reigns
queen, xv., xvi.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p32">1832 The beast ascends from the bottomless pit, xvii.,
xviii.</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p33">1836 The end of the non-chronos, and of the many kings; the
fulfilling of the word, and of the mystery of God; the repentance of the
survivors in the great city; the end of the "little time," and of the
three times and a half; the destruction of the east; the imprisonment of
Satan, xix., xx. Afterward The loosing of Satan for a small time; the
beginning of the thousand years' reign of the saints; the end of the
small time, xx. The end of the world; all things new, xx., xxii. The
several ages, from the time of St. John's being in Patmos, down to the
present time, may, according to the chief incidents mentioned in the
Revelation, be distinguished thus: Age Event As Described In Revelation
Chapter/Verse</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p34">II. The destruction of the Jews by Adrian, C viii. 7</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p35">III. The inroads of the barbarous nations, 8</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p36">IV. The Arian bitterness, 10</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p37">V. The end of the western empire. 12</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p38">VI. The Jews tormented in Persia, ix. 1</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p39">VII. The Saracen cavalry. 13</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p40">VIII. Many kings, x. 11</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p41">IX. The ruler of the nations born, xii. 5</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p42">X. The third woe, 12</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p43">XI. The ascent of the beast out of the pen, xiii. 1</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p44">XII. Power given to the beast, 5</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p45">XIII. War with the saints, 7</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p46">XIV. The middle of the third woe,</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p47">XV. The beast in the midst of his strength,</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p48">XVI. The Reformation; the woman better fed, 9</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p49">XVII. An everlasting gospel promulged, xiv. 6</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p50">XVIII. The worship of the beast and of his image, 9</p>

<p id="i.xxviii.xxiii-p51">O God, whatsoever stands or falls, stands or falls by thy
judgment. Defend thy own truth!Have mercy on me and my readers! To thee
be glory forever!</p>
</div3>
</div2>
</div1>

<div1 title="John Wesley's Notes on The Old Testament" progress="30.94%" prev="i.xxviii.xxiii" next="ii.i" id="ii">
<h1 id="ii-p0.1">JOHN WESLEYS NOTES</h1> 
<h1 id="ii-p0.2">ON THE WHOLE BIBLE</h1> 
<h1 id="ii-p0.3">THE OLD TESTAMENT</h1> 
<h2 id="ii-p0.4">by John Wesley</h2>

<div2 title="PREFACE" progress="30.94%" prev="ii" next="ii.ii" id="ii.i">
<h2 id="ii.i-p0.1">PREFACE</h2> 

<p id="ii.i-p1">ABOUT ten years ago I was prevailed upon to publish
Explanatory Notes upon the New Testament. When that work was begun, and
indeed when it was finished, I had no design to attempt anything farther
of the kind. Nay, I had a full determination, Not to do it, being
throughly fatigued with the immense labour (had it been only this; tho'
this indeed was but a small part of it,) of writing twice over a Quarto
book containing seven or eight hundred pages.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p2">2. But this was scarce published before I was importuned to
write Explanatory Notes upon the Old Testament. This importunity I have
withstood for many years. Over and above the deep conviction I had, of
my insufficiency for such a work, of my want of learning, of
understanding, of spiritual experience, for an undertaking more
difficult by many degrees, than even writing on the New Testament, I
objected, That there were many passages in the Old, which I did not
understand myself, and consequently could not explain to others, either
to their satisfaction, or my own. Above all, I objected the want of
time: Not only as I have a thousand other employments, but as my Day is
near spent, as I am declined into the vale of years. And to this day it
appears to me as a dream, a thing almost incredible, that I should be
entering upon a work of this kind, when I am entering into the
sixty-third year of my age.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p3">3. Indeed these considerations, the last particular, still
appear to me of such weight, that I cannot entertain a thought of
composing a body of Notes on the whole Old Testament. All the question
remaining was, "Is there extant any Exposition which is worth
abridging?" Abundantly less time will suffice for this and less
abilities of every kind. In considering this question, I soon turned my
thought on the well-known Mark Henry. He is allowed by all competent
Judges, to have been a person of strong understanding, of various
learning, of solid piety, and much experience in the ways of God. And
his exposition is generally clear and intelligible, the thoughts being
expressed in plain words: It is also found, agreeable to the tenor of
scripture, and to the analogy of faith. It is frequently full, giving a
sufficient explication of the passages which require explaining. It is
in many parts deep, penetrating farther into the inspired writings than
most other comments do. It does not entertain us with vain speculations,
but is practical throughout: and usually spiritual too teaching us how
to worship God, not in form only, but in spirit and in truth.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p4">4. But it may be reasonably inquired, "If Mark Henry's
exposition be not only plain, sound, full, and deep, but practical, yea
and spiritual too, what need is there of any other? Or how is it
possible to mend This? to alter it for the better?" I answer, very many
who have This, have no need of any other: particularly those who believe
(what runs thro' the whole work and will much recommend it to them) the
doctrine of absolution, irrespective, unconditional Predestination. I do
not advise these, much to trouble themselves about any other exposition
than Mark Henry's: this is sufficient, thro' the assistance of the
Blessed Spirit, to make private Christians wise unto salvation, and (the
Lord applying his word) throughly furnished unto every good work.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p5">5. But then it is manifest on the other hand, every one
cannot have this exposition. It is too large a purchase: there are
thousands who would rejoice to have it; but it bears too high a price.
They have not Six Guineas (the London price) in the world, perhaps from
one year's end to another. And if they sometimes have, yet they have it
not to spare; they need it for other occasions. How much soever
therefore they desire so valuable a work, they must content themselves
to go without it.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p6">6. But suppose they have money enough to purchase, yet they
have not time enough to read it: the size is as unsurmountable an
objection as the price itself. It is not possible for men who have their
daily bread to earn by the sweat of their brows, who generally are
confined to their work, from six in the morning 'till six in the
evening, to find leisure for reading over six folios, each containing
seven or eight hundred pages. These therefore have need of some other
exposition than Mark Henry's. As excellent as it is in its kind, it is
not for their purpose; seeing they have neither money to make the
purchase, nor time to read it over.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p7">7. It is very possible then to mend this work valuable as it
is, at least by shortening it. As the grand objection to it is the size,
that objection may be removed: and they who at present have no
possibility of profiting by it, while it is of so great a bulk and so
high a price, may then enjoy part at least of the same advantage with
those who have more money and more leisure. Few I presume that have the
whole and leisure to read it, will concern themselves with an extract.
But those who cannot have all, will (for the present at least) be glad
to have a part. And they who complain it is too short, may yet serve
themselves of it, 'till they can procure the long work.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p8">8. But I apprehend this valuable work may be made more
valuable still, by making it plainer as well as shorter. Accordingly
what is here extracted from it, (which indeed makes but a small part of
the following volumes) is considerably plainer than the original. In
order to this not only all the Latin sentences occasionally interspersed
are omitted, but whatever phrases or words are not so intelligible to
persons of no education. Those only who frequently and familiarly
converse with men that are wholly uneducated, can conceive how many
expressions are mere Greek to them, which are quite natural to those who
have any share of learning. It is not by reading, much less by musing
alone, that we are enabled to suit our discourse to common capacities.
It is only by actually talking with the vulgar, that we learn to talk in
a manner they can understand. And unless we do this, what do we profit
them? Do we not lose all our labour? Should we speak as angels, we
should be of no more use to them, than sounding brass or a tinkling
cymbal.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p9">9. Nay I apprehend what is extracted from Mark Henry's work,
may in some sense be more sound than the original. Understand me right:
I mean more conformable to that glorious declaration, God willeth all
men to be saved, and to come to the knowledge of his truth. And let it
not be objected, That the making any alteration with regard to a point
of doctrine, is a misrepresentation of the author's sense, and
consequently an injury done to him. It would so, is an alteration were
made of his words, so as to make them bear a different meaning; or if
any words were recited as His, which he did not write. But neither of
these is the case. Nothing is recited here as written by him which he
did not write. Neither is any construction put upon his words, different
from his own. But what he wrote in favour of Particular Redemption, is
totally left out. And of this I here give express notice to the reader
once for all.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p10">10. Again. It certainly possible that a work abundantly
shorter than Mark Henry's may nevertheless be considerably fuller, in
some particulars. There are many words which he passes over without any
explanation at all; as taking it for granted that the reader already
knows the meaning of them. But this is a supposition not to be made; it
is an entire mistake. For instance: What does a common man know of an
Omer, or a Hin? "Why Moses explains his own meaning: "An Omer is the
tenth part of an ephah." True; but what does the honest man know of an
ephah? Just as much as of an Omer. I suppose that which led Mark Henry
into these omissions, which otherwise are unaccountable, was the desire
of not saying what others had said before, Mark Pool in particular. This
is easily gathered from his own words, "Mark Pool's English Annotations
are of admirable use; especially for "the explaining of scripture
phrases, opening the sense and clearing "of difficulties. I have
industriously declined as much as I could what "is to be found there." I
wish he had not. Or at least that he had given us the same sense in
other words. Indeed he adds, "Those "and other annotations are most easy
to be consulted upon occasion." Yes by those that have them: but that is
not the case with the generality of Mark Henry's readers. And besides
they may justly expect that so large a comment will leave them no
occasion to consult others.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p11">11. It is possible likewise to penetrate deeper into the
meaning of some scriptures than Mark Henry has done. Altho' in general
he is far from being a superficial writer, yet he is not always the
same. Indeed if he had, he must have been more than man, considering the
vastness of his work. It was scarce possible for any human
understanding, to furnish out such a number of folios, without sinking
sometimes into trite reflections and observations, rather lively than
deep. A stream that runs wide and covers a large tract of land, will be
shallow in some places. If it had been confined within a moderate
channel, it might have flowed deep all along.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p12">12. Nay, it cannot be denied, that there may be an exposition
of scripture more closely practical, than some parts of Mark Henry's
are, as well as more spiritual. Even his exposition of the twentieth
chapter of Exodus, where one would naturally have expected to find a
compleat scheme of Christian practice, does not answer that expectation.
Nor do I remember that he has any where given us, a satisfactory account
of Spiritual Religion, of the kingdom of God within us, the fruit of
Christ dwelling and reigning in the heart. This I hoped to have found
particularly in the exposition of our Lord's Sermon upon the mount. But
I was quite disappointed of my hope. It was not by any means what I
expected.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p13">13. I do not therefore intend the following Notes for a bare
abridgment of Mark Henry's exposition. Far from it: I not only omit much
more than nineteen parts out of twenty of what he has written, but make
many alterations and many additions, well nigh from the beginning to the
end. In particular, I everywhere omit the far greater part of his
inferences from and improvement of the chapter. They who think these the
most valuable part of the work, may have recourse to the author himself.
I likewise omit great part of almost every note, the sum of which is
retained: as it seems to be his aim, to say as much, whereas it is mine
to say as little as possible. And I omit abundance of quaint sayings and
lively antitheses; as, "God feeds his birds. Shall he not feed his
babes!" "Pharaoh's princes: his pimps rather." Indeed every thing of
this kind which occurred I have left quite untouched: altho' I am
sensible these are the very flowers which numberless readers admire; nay
which many, I doubt not, apprehend to be the chief beauties of the book.
For that very reason I cannot but wish, they had never had a place
therein; for this is a blemish, which is exceeding catching: he that
admires it, will quickly imitate it. I used once to wonder, whence some
whom I greatly esteem, had so many pretty turns in preaching. But when I
read Mark Henry, my wonder ceased. I saw, they were only copying after
him: altho' many of them probably without designing or even adverting to
it. They generally consulted his exposition of their text, and
frequently just before preaching. And hence little witticisms and a kind
of archness insensibly stole upon them, and took place of that strong,
manly eloquence, which they would otherwise have learned from the
inspired writers.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p14">14. With regard to alterations, in what I take from Mark
Henry, I continually alter hard words into easy, and long sentences into
short. But I do not knowingly alter the sense of any thing I extract
from him, I only endeavour in several places, to make it more clear and
determinate. I have here and there taken the liberty of altering a word
in the text. But this I have done very sparingly, being afraid of
venturing too far; as being conscious of my very imperfect acquaintance
with the Hebrew tongue. I have added very largely from Mark Pool, as
much as seemed necessary for common readers, in order to their
understanding those words or passages, which Mark Henry does not
explain. Nay, from the time that I had more maturely considered Mark
Pool's annotations on the Bible, (which was soon after I had gone thro'
the book of Genesis) I have extracted far more from him than from Mark
Henry: it having been my constant method, after reading the text, first
to read and weigh what Mark Pool observed upon every verse, and
afterwards to consult Mark Henry's exposition of the whole paragraph. In
consequence of this, instead of short additions from Mark Pool to supply
what was wanting in Mark Henry, (which was my first design) I now only
make extracts from Mark Henry, to supply so far as they are capable,
what was wanting in Mark Pool. I say, so far as they are capable: for I
still found in needful to add to both such farther observations, as have
from time to time occurred to my own mind in reading or thinking on the
scriptures, together with such as I have occasionally extracted from
other authors.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p15">15. Every thinking man will now easily discern my design in
the following sheets. It is not, to write sermons, essays or set
discourses, upon any part of scripture. It is not to draw inferences
from the text, or to shew what doctrines may be proved thereby. It is
this: To give the direct, literal meaning, of every verse, of every
sentence, and as far as I am able, of every word in the oracles of God.
I design only, like the hand of a dial, to point every man to This: not
to take up his mind with something else, how excellent soever: but to
keep his eye fixt upon the naked Bible, that he may read and hear it
with understanding. I say again, (and desire it may be well observed,
that none may expect what they will not find) It is not my design to
write a book, which a man may read separate from the Bible: but barely
to assist those who fear God, in hearing and reading the bible itself,
by shewing the natural sense of every part, in as few and plain words as
I can.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p16">16. And I am not without hopes, that the following notes may
in some measure answer this end, not barely to unlettered and ignorant
men, but also to men of education and, learning: (altho' it is true,
neither these nor the Notes on the New Testament were principally
designed for Them.) Sure I am, that tracts wrote in the most plain and
simple manner, are of infinitely more service to me, than those which
are elabourated with the utmost skill, and set off with the greatest
pomp of erudition.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p17">17. But it is no part of my design, to save either learned or
unlearned men from the trouble of thinking. If so, I might perhaps write
Folios too, which usually overlay, rather than help the thought. On the
contrary, my intention is, to make them think, and assist them in
thinking. This is the way to understand the things of God; Meditate
thereon day and night; So shall you attain the best knowledge; even to
know the only true God and Jesus Christ whom He hath sent. And this
knowledge will lead you, to love Him, because he hath first loved us:
yea, to love the Lord your God with all your heart, and with all your
soul, and with all your mind, and with all your strength. Will there not
then be all that mind in you, which was also in Christ Jesus? And in
consequence of this, while you joyfully experience all the holy tempers
described in this book, you will likewise be outwardly holy as He that
hath called you is holy, in all manner of conversation.</p>

<p id="ii.i-p18">18. If you desire to read the scripture in such a manner as
may most effectually answer this end, would it not be advisable,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.i-p19">1. To set apart a little time, if you can,
every morning and evening for that purpose?</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.i-p20">2. At each time if you have leisure, to read a
chapter out of the Old, and one out of the New Testament: is you cannot
do this, to take a single chapter, or a part of one?</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.i-p21">3. To read this with a single eye, to know the
whole will of God, and a fixt resolution to do it? In order to know his
will, you should,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.i-p22">4. Have a constant eye to the analogy of faith;
the connection and harmony there is between those grand, fundamental
doctrines, Original Sin, Justification by Faith, the New Birth, Inward
and Outward Holiness.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.i-p23">5. Serious and earnest prayer should be
constantly used, before we consult the oracles of God, seeing "scripture
can only be understood thro' the same Spirit whereby "it was given." Our
reading should likewise be closed with prayer, that what we read may be
written on our hearts.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.i-p24">6. It might also be of use, if while we read,
we were frequently to pause, and examine ourselves by what we read, both
with regard to our hearts, and lives. This would furnish us with matter
of praise, where we found God had enabled us to conform to his blessed
will, and matter of humiliation and prayer, where we were conscious of
having fallen short. And whatever light you then receive, should be used
to the uttermost, and that immediately. Let there be no delay. Whatever
you resolve, begin to execute the first moment you can. So shall you
find this word to be indeed the power of God unto present and eternal
salvation. EDINBURGH, April 25, 1765.</p>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE FIRST BOOK OF MOSES CALLED GENESIS" progress="31.24%" prev="ii.i" next="ii.ii.i" id="ii.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen" id="ii.ii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.ii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE FIRST BOOK OF MOSES CALLED GENESIS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Genesis" progress="31.24%" prev="ii.ii" next="ii.ii.ii" id="ii.ii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.i-p1">THE Holy Bible, or Book, is so called by way of eminency,
as it is the best book that ever was written. The great things of God's
law and gospel are here written, that they might be reduced to a greater
certainty, might spread farther, remain longer, and be transmitted to
distant places and ages, more pure and entire than possibly they could
be by tradition. That part of the Bible which we call the Old Testament,
contains the acts and monuments of the church from the creation, almost
to the coming of Christ in the flesh, which was about four thousand
years: the truths then revealed, the laws enacted, the prophecies given,
and the chief events that concerned the church. This is called a
testament or covenant, because it was a declaration of the will of God
concerning man in a federal way, and had its force from the designed
death of the great testator, the Lamb slain from the foundation of the
world, <scripRef passage="Rev. xiii. 8" id="ii.ii.i-p1.1" parsed="|Rev|13|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.13.8">Rev. xiii, 8</scripRef> - 'Tis called the Old Testament with relation to the New,
which doth not cancel, but crown and perfect it, by bringing in that
better hope which was typified and foretold in it. This part of the Old
Testament we call the Pentateuch, or five books of Moses. These books
were, probably, the first that ever were written; for we have no mention
of any writing in all the book of Genesis, nor 'till God bid Moses
write, <scripRef passage="Exod. xvii. 14" id="ii.ii.i-p1.2" parsed="|Exod|17|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.17.14">Exod. xvii, 14</scripRef>. and set him his copy in the writing of the ten commandments
upon the tables of stone. However, we are sure these books are the most
ancient writings now extant. The first of these, which we call Genesis,
Moses probably wrote in the wilderness, after he had been in the mount
with God. And as he framed the tabernacle, so he did the more excellent
and durable fabric of this book, according to the pattern shewed him in
the mount: into which it is better to resolve the certainty of the
things herein contained, than into any tradition which possibly might be
handed down to the family of Jacob.-Genesis is a name borrowed from the
Greek: it signifies the original or generation: fitly is this book so
called, for it is a history of originals; the creation of the world, the
entrance of sin and death into it, the invention of arts, the rise of
nations, and especially the planting of the church, and the state of it
in its early days. 'Tis also a history of generations, the generations
of Adam, Noah, Abraham, &amp;c. - The beginning of the New Testament is
called Genesis too, <scripRef passage="Matt. i. 1" id="ii.ii.i-p1.3" parsed="|Matt|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.1.1">Matt. i, 1</scripRef>, the book of the Genesis, or generation of Jesus Christ.
Lord, open our eyes, that we may see the wondrous things both of thy law
and gospel!</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="31.29%" prev="ii.ii.i" next="ii.ii.ii.i" id="ii.ii.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. I" id="ii.ii.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 1" progress="31.29%" prev="ii.ii.ii" next="ii.ii.ii.ii" id="ii.ii.ii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.ii.i-p1">The holy scripture, being designed to maintain and
improve natural religion, to repair the decays of it. and supply the
defects of it, since the fall, lays down at first this principle of the
unclouded light of nature: That this world was, in the beginning of
time, created by a Being of infinite wisdom and power, who was himself
before all time, and all worlds. And the first verse of the Bible gives
us a surer and better, a more satisfying and useful knowledge of the
origin of the universe, than all the volumes of the philosophers. We
have three things in this chapter.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.ii.i-p2">I. A general idea of the work of creation,
ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.ii.i-p3">II. A particular account of the several
days work, distinctly and in order. The creation of light, the first
day, ver. 3-5. Of the firmament, the second day, ver. 6-8. Of the sea,
the earth and its fruits, the third day, ver. 9-13. Of the lights of
heaven, the fourth day, ver. 14-19. Of the fish and fowl, the fifth day,
ver. 20-23. Of the beasts, ver. 24, 25. Of man, ver. 26-28. And food for
both, the sixth day, ver. 29, 30.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.ii.i-p4">III. The review and approbation of the
whole work, ver. 31.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.ii.i-p5">1. Observe here.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.i-p6">1. The effect produced, The heaven and the
earth - That is, the world, including the whole frame and furniture of
the universe. But 'tis only the visible part of the creation that Moses
designs to give an account of. Yet even in this there are secrets which
cannot be fathomed, nor accounted for. But from what we see of heaven
and earth, we may infer the eternal power and godhead of the great
Creator. And let our make and place, as men, mind us of our duty, as
Christians, which is always to keep heaven in our eye, and the earth
under our feet. Observe</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.i-p7">2. The author and cause of this great work,
God. The Hebrew word is Elohim; which (1.) seems to mean The Covenant
God, being derived from a word that signifies to swear. (2.) The
plurality of persons in the Godhead, Father, Son, and Holy Ghost. The
plural name of God in Hebrew, which speaks of him as many, tho' he be
but one, was to the Gentiles perhaps a favour of death unto death,
hardening them in their idolatry; but it is to us a favour of life unto
life, confirming our faith in the doctrine of the Trinity, which, tho'
but darkly intimated in the Old Testament, is clearly revealed in the
New. Observe</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.i-p8">3. The manner how this work was effected;
God created, that is, made it out of nothing. There was not any
pre-existent matter out of which the world was produced. The fish and
fowl were indeed produced out of the waters, and the beasts and man out
of the earth; but that earth and those waters were made out of nothing.
Observe</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.i-p9">4. When this work was produced; In the
beginning - That is, in the beginning of time. Time began with the
production of those beings that are measured by time. Before the
beginning of time there was none but that Infinite Being that inhabits
eternity. Should we ask why God made the world no sooner, we should but
darken counsel by words without knowledge; for how could there be sooner
or later in eternity?</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.ii.i-p10">2. Where we have an account of the first
matter, and the first Mover.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 1" progress="31.34%" prev="ii.ii.ii.i" next="ii.ii.iii" id="ii.ii.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p1">1. A chaos was the first matter. 'Tis here called the
earth, (tho' the earth, properly taken, was not made 'till the third
day, ver. 10) because it did most resemble that which was afterwards
called earth, a heavy unwieldy mass. 'Tis also called the deep, both for
its vastness, and because the waters which were afterwards separated
from the earth were now mixed with it. This mighty bulk of matter was
it, out of which all bodies were afterwards produced. The Creator could
have made his work perfect at first, but by this gradual proceeding he
would shew what is ordinarily the method of his providence, and grace.
This chaos, was without form and void. Tohu and Bohu, confusion and
emptiness, so those words are rendered, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxxiv. 11" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Isa|34|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.34.11">Isaiah xxxiv, 11</scripRef>. 'Twas shapeless, 'twas useless, 'twas without inhabitants,
without ornaments; the shadow or rough draught of things to come. To
those who have their hearts in heaven, this lower world, in comparison
of the upper, still appears to be confusion and emptiness. And darkness
was upon the face of the deep-God did not create this darkness, (as he
is said to create the darkness of affliction, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xlv. 7" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Isa|45|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.45.7">Isaiah xlv,
7</scripRef>.) for it was only the want of light.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p2">2. The Spirit of God was the first Mover; He moved upon
the face of the waters - He moved upon the face of the deep, as the hen
gathereth her chicken under her wings, and hovers over them, to warm and
cherish them, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 37" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|23|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.37">Matt. xxiii,
37</scripRef> as the eagle stirs up her nest, and fluttereth over her
young, ('tis the same word that is here used) <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 11" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Deut|32|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.11">Deut. xxxii, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p3">3, 4, 5. We have here a farther account of the first
day's work. In which observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p4">1. That the first of all visible beings
which God created was light, the great beauty and blessing of the
universe: like the first-born, it doth, of all visible beings, most
resemble its great parent in purity and power, brightness and
beneficence.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p5">2. That the light was made by the word of
God's power; He said, Let there be light - He willed it, and it was
done; there was light - Such a copy as exactly answered the original
idea in the eternal mind.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p6">3. That the light which God willed, he
approved of. God saw the light, that it was good - 'Twas exactly as he
designed it; and it was fit to answer the end for which he designed
it.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p7">4. That God divided the light from the
darkness - So put them asunder as they could never be joined together:
and yet he divided time between them, the day for light, and the night
for darkness, in a constant succession. Tho' the darkness was now
scattered by the light, yet it has its place, because it has its use;
for as the light of the morning befriends the business of the day, so
the shadows of the evening befriend the repose of the night. God has
thus divided between light and darkness, because he would daily mind us
that this is a world of mixtures and changes. In heaven there is
perpetual light, and no darkness; in hell utter darkness, and no light:
but in this world they are counter-changed, and we pass daily from one
to another; that we may learn to expect the like vicissitudes in the
providence of God.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p8">5. That God divided them from each other by
distinguishing names. He called the light Day, and the darkness he
called night - He gave them names as Lord of both. He is the Lord of
time, and will be so 'till day and night shall come to an end, and the
stream of time be swallowed up in the ocean of eternity.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p9">6. That this was the first day's work, The
evening and the morning were the first day - The darkness of the evening
was before the light of the morning, that it might set it off, and make
it shine the brighter. See note at "ver. 3"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p10">6, 7, 8. We have here an account of the second day's
work, the creation of the firmament. In which observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p11">1. The command of God: Let there be a
firmament - An expansion; so the Hebrew word signifies, like a sheet
spread, or a curtain drawn out. This includes all that is visible above
the earth, between it and the third heavens, the air, its higher,
middle, and lower region, the celestial globe, and all the orbs of light
above; it reaches as high as the place where the stars are fixed, for
that is called here the firmament of heaven, ver. 14, 15, and as low as
the place where the birds fly for that also is called the firmament of
heaven, ver. 20.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p12">2. The creation of it: and God made the
firmament.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p13">3. The design of it; to divide the waters
from the waters-That is, to distinguish between the waters that are
wrapt up in the clouds, and those that cover the sea; the waters in the
air, and those in the earth.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p14">4. The naming it: He called the firmament
Heaven - 'Tis the visible heaven, the pavement of the holy city. The
height of the heavens should mind us of God's supremacy, and the
infinite distance that is between us and him; the brightness of the
heavens, and their purity, should mind us of his majesty, and perfect
holiness; the vastness of the heavens, and their encompassing the earth,
and influence upon it, should mind us of his immensity and universal
providence. See note at "ver. 6"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p15">9, 10, 11, 12, 13. The third day's work is related in
these verses; the forming the sea and the dry land, and making the earth
fruitful. Hitherto the power of the Creator had been employed about the
upper part of the visible world; now he descends to this lower world,
designed for the children of men, both for their habitation, and their
maintenance. And here we have an account of the fitting of it for both;
the building of their house, and the spreading of their table.
Observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p16">1. How the earth was prepared to be a
habitation for man by the gathering of the waters together, and making
the dry land appear. Thus, instead of that confusion which was, when
earth and water were mixed in one great mass; now there is order, by
such a separation as rendered them both useful. (1.) The waters which
covered the earth were ordered to retire, and to gather into one place,
viz. those hollows which were fitted for their reception. The waters
thus lodged in their proper place, he called Seas; for though they are
many, in distant regions, yet either above ground or under ground, they
have communication with each other, and so they are one, and the common
receptacle of waters, into which all the rivers run. (2.) The dry land
was made to appear, and emerge out of the waters, and was called Earth.
Observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p17">2. How the earth was furnished for the
support of man, ver. 11, 12. Present provision was made, by the
immediate products of the earth, which, in obedience to God's command,
was no sooner made but it became fruitful. Provision was likewise made
for time to come, by the perpetuating of the several species of
vegetables, every one having its seed in itself after its kind, that
during the continuance of man upon the earth, food might be fetched out
of the earth, for his use and benefit. See note at "ver. 9"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p18">14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19. This is the history of the fourth
day's work, the creating the sun, moon and stars. Of this we have an
account,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p19">1. In general, verse 14, 15. where we have,
(1.) The command given concerning them. Let there be lights in the
firmament of heaven - God had said, ver. 3 Let there be light, and there
was light; but that was, as it were, a chaos of light, scattered and
confused; now it was collected and made into several luminaries, and so
rendered both more glorious and more serviceable. (2.) The use they were
intended to be of to this earth. [1.] They must be for the distinction
of times, of day and night, summer and winter. [2.] They must be for the
direction of actions: they are for signs of the change of weather, that
the husbandman may order his affairs with discretion. They do also give
light upon the earth - That we may walk <scripRef passage="John xi. 9" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|John|11|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.11.9">John xi, 9</scripRef> and work <scripRef passage="John ix. 4" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p19.2" parsed="|John|9|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.9.4">John ix, 4</scripRef> according as the duty of every day requires. The lights of
heaven do not shine for themselves, nor for the world of spirits above,
they need them not; but they shine for us, and for our pleasure and
advantage. Lord, what is man that he should be thus regarded, <scripRef passage="Psalm viii. 3, 4" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p19.3" parsed="|Ps|8|3|8|4" osisRef="Bible:Ps.8.3-Ps.8.4">Psalm viii, 3, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p20">2. In particular, ver. 16, 17, 18, The
lights of heaven are the sun, moon and stars, and these all are the work
of God's hands. (1.) The sun is the greatest light of all, and the most
glorious and useful of all the lamps of heaven; a noble instance of the
Creator's wisdom, power and goodness, and an invaluable blessing to the
creatures of this lower world. (2.) The moon is a lesser light, and yet
is here reckoned one of the greater lights, because, though in regard of
its magnitude, it is inferior to many of the stars, yet in respect of
its usefulness to the earth, it is more excellent than they. (3.) He
made the stars also - Which are here spoken of only in general; for the
scriptures were written not to gratify our curiosity, but to lead us to
God. Now, these lights are said to rule, ver. 16, 18; not that they have
a supreme dominion as God has, but they are rulers under him. Here the
lesser light, the moon, is said to rule the night; but <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p20.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xxxvi, 9
the stars are mentioned as sharers in that government, the moon and
stars to rule by night. No more is meant, but that they give light, <scripRef passage="Jer. xxxi. 35" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p20.2" parsed="|Jer|31|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.31.35">Jer. xxxi, 35</scripRef>. The best and most honourable way of ruling is, by giving
light, and doing good. See note at "ver. 14"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p21">20, 21, 22, 23. Each day hitherto hath produced very
excellent beings, but we do not read of the creation of any living
creature till the fifth day. The work of creation not only proceeded
gradually from one thing to another, but advanced gradually from that
which was less excellent, to that which was more so. 'Twas on the fifth
day that the fish and fowl were created, and both out of the waters.
Observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p22">1. The making of the fish and fowl at
first. ver. 20, 21 God commanded them to be produced, he said, Let the
waters bring forth abundantly - The fish in the waters, and the fowl out
of them. This command he himself executed, God created great whales,
&amp;c.-Insects which are as various as any species of animals, and
their structure as curious, were part of this day's work, some of them
being allied to the fish, and others to the fowl. Notice is here taken
of the various species of fish and fowl, each after their kind; and of
the great numbers of both that were produced, for the waters brought
forth abundantly; and in particular of great whales the largest of
fishes, whose bulk and strength, are remarkable proofs of the power and
greatness of the Creator. Observe, 2, The blessing of them in order to
their continuance. Life is a wasting thing, its strength is not the
strength of stones; therefore the wise Creator not only made the
individuals, but provided for the propagating of the several species,
ver. 22. God blessed them, saying, Be fruitful, and multiply -
Fruitfulness is the effect of God's blessing, and must be ascribed to
it; the multiplying of the fish and fowl from year to year, is still the
fruit of this blessing here. See note at "ver. 20"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p23">24, 25. We have here the first part of the sixth day's
work. The sea was the day before replenished with fish, and the air with
fowl; and this day are made the beasts of the earth, cattle, and the
creeping things that pertain to the earth. Here, as before,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p24">1. The Lord gave the word: he said, Let The
earth bring forth - Let these creatures come into being upon the earth,
and out of it, in their respective kinds.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p25">2. He also did the work; he made them all
after their kind - Not only of divers shapes, but of divers natures,
manners, food, and fashions: In all which appears the manifold wisdom of
the Creator. See note at "ver. 2"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p26">26, 27, 28. We have here the second part of the sixth
day's work, the creation of man, which we are in a special manner
concerned to take notice of. Observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p27">1. That man was made last of all the
creatures, which was both an honour and a favour to him: an honour, for
the creation was to advance from that which was less perfect, to that
which was more so and a favour, for it was not fit he should be lodged
in the palace designed for him, till it was completely fitted and
furnished for his reception. Man, as soon as he was made, had the whole
visible creation before him, both to contemplate, and to take the
comfort of.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p28">2. That man's creation was a mere signal
act of divine wisdom and power, than that of the other creatures. The
narrative of it is introduced with solemnity, and a manifest distinction
from the rest. Hitherto it had been said, Let there be light, and Let
there be a firmament: but now the word of command is turned into a word
of consultation, Let us make man - For whose sake the rest of the
creatures were made. Man was to be a creature different from all that
had been hitherto made. Flesh and spirit, heaven and earth must be put
together in him, and he must be allied to both worlds. And therefore God
himself not only undertakes to make, but is pleased so to express
himself, as if he called a council to consider of the making of him; Let
us make man - The three persons of the Trinity, Father, Son, and Holy
Ghost, consult about it, and concur in it; because man, when he was
made, was to be dedicated and devoted to Father, Son, and Holy
Ghost.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p29">3. That man was made in God's image, and
after his likeness; two words to express the same thing. God's image
upon man, consists,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p30">1. In his nature, not that of his body, for
God has not a body, but that of his soul. The soul is a spirit, an
intelligent, immortal spirit, an active spirit, herein resembling God,
the Father of spirits, and the soul of the world.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p31">2. In his place and authority. Let us make
man in our image, and let him have dominion. As he has the government of
the inferior creatures, he is as it were God's representative on earth.
Yet his government of himself by the freedom of his will, has in it more
of God's image, than his government of the creatures.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p32">3. And chiefly in his purity and rectitude.
God's image upon man consists in knowledge, righteousness, and true
holiness, <scripRef passage="Eph. iv. 24" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p32.1" parsed="|Eph|4|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.4.24">Eph. iv, 24</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Colossians iii. 10" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p32.2" parsed="|Col|3|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.3.10">Colossians iii, 10</scripRef>. He was upright, <scripRef passage="Eccl. vii. 29" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p32.3" parsed="|Eccl|7|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eccl.7.29">Eccl. vii, 29</scripRef>. He had an habitual conformity of all his natural powers to
the whole will of God. His understanding saw divine things clearly, and
there were no errors in his knowledge: his will complied readily and
universally with the will of God; without reluctancy: his affections
were all regular, and he had no inordinate appetites or passions: his
thoughts were easily fixed to the best subjects, and there was no vanity
or ungovernableness in them. And all the inferior powers were subject to
the dictates of the superior. Thus holy, thus happy, were our first
parents, in having the image of God upon them. But how art thou fallen,
O son of the morning? How is this image of God upon man defaced! How
small are the remains of it, and how great the ruins of it! The Lord
renew it upon our souls by his sanctifying grace!</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p33">4. That man was made male and female, and
blessed with fruitfulness. He created him male and female, Adam and Eve:
Adam first out of earth, and Eve out of his side. God made but one male
and one female, that all the nations of men might know themselves to be
made of one blood, descendants, from one common stock, and might thereby
be induced to love one another. God having made them capable of
transmitting the nature they had received, said to them, Be fruitful,
and multiply, and replenish the earth - Here he gave them,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p34">1. A large inheritance; replenish the
earth, in which God has set man to be the servant of his providence, in
the government of the inferior creatures, and as it were the
intelligence of this orb; to be likewise the collector of his praises in
this lower world, and lastly, to be a probationer for a better
state.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p35">2. A numerous lasting family to enjoy this
inheritance; pronouncing a blessing upon them, in the virtue of which,
their posterity should extend to the utmost corners of the earth, and
continue to the utmost period of time.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p36">5. That God gave to man a dominion over the
inferior creatures, over fish of the sea, and over the fowl of the air -
Though man provides for neither, he has power over both, much more over
every living thing that moveth upon the earth - God designed hereby to
put an honour upon man, that he might find himself the more strongly
obliged to bring honour to his Maker. See note at "ver. 26"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p37">29, 30. We have here the third part of the sixth day's
work, which was not any new creation, but a gracious provision of food
for all flesh, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p37.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xxxvi, 25.-Here is,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p38">1. Food provided for man, ver. 29. herbs
and fruits must be his meat, including corn, and all the products of the
earth. And before the earth was deluged, much more before it was cursed
for man's sake, its fruits no doubt, were more pleasing to the taste,
and more strengthening and nourishing to the body.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p39">2. Food provided for the beasts, ver. 30.
Doth God take care of oxen? Yes, certainly, he provides food convenient
for them; and not for oxen only that were used in his sacrifices, and
man's service, but even the young lions and the young ravens are the
care of his providence, they ask and have their meat from God. See note
at "ver. 29"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p40">31. We have here the approbation and conclusion of the
whole work of creation. Observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p41">1. The review God took of his work, he saw
every thing that he had made - So he doth still; all the works of his
hands are under his eye; he that made all sees all.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p42">2. The complacency God took in his work.
When we come to review our works we find to our shame, that much has
been very bad; but when God reviewed his, all was very good.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p43">1. It was good. Good, for it is all
agreeable to the mind of the creator. Good, for it answers the end of
its creation. Good, for it is serviceable to man, whom God had appointed
Lord of the visible creation. Good, for it is all for God's glory; there
is that in the whole visible creation which is a demonstration of God's
being and perfections, and which tends to beget in the soul of man a
religious regard to him.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p44">2. It was very good - Of each day's work
(except the second) it was said that it was good, but now it is very
good. For,</p>

<p class="List5" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p45">1. Now man was made, who was the chief of
the ways of God, the visible image of the Creator's glory,</p>

<p class="List5" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p46">2. Now All was made, every part was good,
but all together very good. The glory and goodness, the beauty and
harmony of God's works both of providence and grace, as this of
creation, will best appear when they are perfected.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ii.ii-p47">3. The time when this work was concluded.
The evening and the morning were the sixth day - So that in six days God
made the world. We are not to think but that God could have made the
world in an instant: but he did it in six days, that he might shew
himself a free agent, doing his own work, both in his own way, and in
his own time; that his wisdom, power and goodness, might appear to us,
and be meditated upon by us, the more distinctly; and that he might set
us an example of working six days, and resting the seventh. And now as
God reviewed his work, let us review our meditations upon it; let us
stir up ourselves, and all that is within us, to worship him that made
the, heaven, earth, and sea, and the fountains of waters. All his works
in all places of his dominion bless him, and therefore bless thou the
Lord, O my soul.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="31.68%" prev="ii.ii.ii.ii" next="ii.ii.iii.i" id="ii.ii.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. II" id="ii.ii.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 2" progress="31.68%" prev="ii.ii.iii" next="ii.ii.iii.ii" id="ii.ii.iii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.iii.i-p1">This chapter is an appendix to the history of the
creation, explaining, and enlarging on that part of it, which relates
immediately to man. We have in it,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iii.i-p2">I. The institution of the sabbath, which
was made for man, to further his holiness and comfort, ver. 1-3.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iii.i-p3">II. A more particular account of man's
creation, as the summary of the whole work, ver. 4-7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iii.i-p4">III. A description of the garden of Eden,
and the placing of man in it under the obligations of a law and
covenant, ver. 8-17.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iii.i-p5">IV. The creation of the woman, her marriage
to the man, and the institution of the ordinance of marriage, ver.
18-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 2" progress="31.69%" prev="ii.ii.iii.i" next="ii.ii.iv" id="ii.ii.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p1">1, 2, 3. We have here, (1.) The settlement of the kingdom
of nature, in God's resting from the work of creation, ver. 1, 2. Where
observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p2">1. That the creatures made both in heaven
and earth, are the hosts or armies of them, which speaks them numerous,
but marshalled, disciplined, and under command. God useth them as his
hosts for the defense of his people, and the destruction of his
enemies.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p3">2. That the heavens and the earth are
finished pieces, and so are all the creatures in them. So perfect is
God's work that nothing can be added to it or taken from it, <scripRef passage="Eccl iii. 14" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Eccl|3|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eccl.3.14">Eccl iii, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p4">3. That after the end of the first six
days, God ceased from all work of creation. He hath so ended his work,
as that though in his providence he worketh hitherto, <scripRef passage="John v. 17" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|John|5|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.5.17">John v, 17</scripRef>. preserving and governing all the creatures, yet he doth not
make any new species of creatures.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p5">4. That the eternal God, tho' infinitely
happy in himself, yet took a satisfaction in the work of his own hands.
He did not rest as one weary, but as one well-pleased with the instances
of his own goodness. (2.) The commencement of the kingdom of grace, in
the sanctification of the sabbath day, ver. 3. He rested on that day,
and took a complacency in his creatures, and then sanctified it, and
appointed us on that day to rest and take a complacency in the Creator;
and his rest is in the fourth commandment made a reason for ours after
six days labour. Observe,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p6">1. That the solemn observation of one day
in seven as a day of holy rest, and holy work, is the indispensible duty
of all those to whom God has revealed his holy sabbaths.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p7">2. That sabbaths are as ancient as the
world.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p8">3. That the sabbath of the Lord is truly
honourable, and we have reason to honour it; honour it for the sake of
its antiquity, its great author, and the sanctification of the first
sabbath by the holy God himself, and in obedience to him, by our first
parents in innocency. See note at "ver. 1"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p9">4, 5, 6, 7. In these verses,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p10">1. Here is a name given to the Creator,
which we have not yet met with, Jehovah. The LORD in capital letters, is
constantly used in our English translation, for Jehovah. This is that
great and incommunicable name of God, which speaks his having his being
of himself, and his giving being to all things. It properly means, He
that was, and that is, and that is to come.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p11">2. Further notice taken of the production
of plants and herbs, because they were made to be food for man.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p12">3. A more particular account of the
creation of man, ver. 7. Man is a little world, consisting of heaven and
earth, soul and body. Here we have all account of the original of both,
and the putting of both together: The Lord God, the great fountain of
being and power, formed man. Of the other creatures it is said, they
were created and made; but of man, that he was formed, which notes a
gradual process in the work with great accuracy and exactness. To
express the creation of this new thing, he takes a new word: a word
(some think) borrowed from the potter's forming his vessel upon the
wheel. The body of man is curiously wrought. And the soul takes its rise
from the breath of heaven. It came immediately from God; he gave it to
be put into the body, <scripRef passage="Eccl xii. 7" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Eccl|12|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eccl.12.7">Eccl xii,
7</scripRef> as afterwards he gave the tables of stone of his own writing
to be put into the ark. 'Tis by it that man is a living soul, that is, a
living man. The body would be a worthless, useless carcase, if the soul
did not animate it. See note at "ver. 4"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p13">8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15. Man consisting of body and
soul, a body made out of the earth, and a rational immortal soul, we
have in these verses the provision that was made for the happiness of
both. That part of man, which is allied to the world of sense, was made
happy, for he was put in the paradise of God; that part which is allied
to the world of spirits was well provided for, for he was taken into
covenant with God. Here we have,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p14">1. A description of the garden of Eden,
which was intended for the palace of this prince. The inspired penman in
this history writing for the Jews first, and calculating his narratives
from the infant state of the church, describes things by their outward
sensible appearances, and leaves us, by farther discoveries of the
divine light, to be led into the understanding of the mysteries couched
under them. Therefore he doth not so much insist upon the happiness of
Adam's mind, as upon that of his outward estate. The Mosaic history, as
well as the Mosaic law, has rather the patterns of heavenly things, than
the heavenly things themselves, <scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 23" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Heb|9|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.23">Heb. ix,
23</scripRef>. Observe, (1.) The place appointed for Adam's residence was
a garden; not an ivory house. As clothes came in with sin, so did
houses. The heaven was the roof of Adam's house, and never was any roof
so curiously cieled and painted: the earth was his floor, and never was
any floor so richly inlaid: the shadow of the trees was his retirement,
and never were any rooms so finely hung: Solomon's in all their glory
were not arrayed like them. (2.) The contrivance and furniture of this
garden was the immediate work of God's wisdom and power. The Lord God
planted this garden, that is, he had planted it, upon the third day when
the fruits of the earth were made. We may well suppose it to be the most
accomplished place that ever the sun saw, when the All-sufficient God
himself designed it to be the present happiness of his beloved creature.
(3.) The situation of this garden was extremely sweet; it was in Eden,
which signifies delight and pleasure. The place is here particularly
pointed out by such marks and bounds as were sufficient when Moses
wrote, to specify the place to those who knew that country; but now it
seems the curious cannot satisfy themselves concerning it. Let it be our
care to make sure a place in the heavenly paradise, and then we need not
perplex ourselves with a search after the place of the earthly paradise.
(4.) The trees wherewith this garden was planted. [1.] It had all the
best and choicest trees in common with the rest of the ground. It was
beautified with every tree that was pleasant to the sight - It was
enriched with every tree that yielded fruit grateful to the taste, and
useful to the body. But, [2.] It had two extraordinary trees peculiar to
itself, on earth there were not their like.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p15">1. There was the tree of life in the midst
of the garden - Which was not so much a natural means to preserve or
prolong life; but was chiefly intended to be a sign to Adam, assuring
him of the continuance of life and happiness upon condition of his
perseverance in innocency and obedience.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p16">2. There was the tree of the knowledge of
good and evil - So called, not because it had any virtue to beget useful
knowledge, but because there was an express Revelation of the will of
God concerning this tree, so that by it he might know good and evil.
What is good? It is good not to eat of this tree: what is evil? To eat
of this tree. The distinction between all other moral good and evil was
written in the heart of man; but this, which resulted from a positive
law, was written upon this tree. And in the event it proved to give Adam
an experimental knowledge of good by the loss of it, and of evil by the
sense of it. (5.) The rivers wherewith this garden was watered, ver.
10-14. These four rivers, (or one river branched into four streams)
contributed much both to the pleasantness and the fruitfulness of this
garden. Hiddekel and Euphrates are rivers of Babylon. Havilah had gold
and spices and precious stones; but Eden had that which was infinitely
better, the tree of life, and communion with God.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p17">2. The command which God gave to man in
innocency, and the covenant he than took him into. Hither we have seen
God; man's powerful Creator, and his bountiful benefactor; now he
appears as his ruler and lawgiver. See note at "ver. 8"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p18">16, 17. Thou shall die - That is, thou shalt lose all the
happiness thou hast either in possession or prospect; and thou shalt
become liable to death, and all the miseries that preface and attend it.
This was threatened as the immediate consequence of sin. In the day thou
eatest, thou shalt die - Not only thou shalt become mortal, but
spiritual death and the forerunners of temporal death shall immediately
seize thee. See note at "ver. 17"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p19">18, 19, 20. It is not good that man - This man, should be
alone - Though there was an upper world of angels, and a lower world of
brutes, yet there being none of the same rank of beings with himself, he
might be truly said to be alone. And every beast of the field, and every
fowl of the air God brought to Adam-Either by the ministry of angels, or
by a special instinct that he might name them, and so might give a proof
of his knowledge, the names he gave them being expressive of their
inmost natures. See note at "ver. 18"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p20">21, 22. This was done upon the sixth day, as was also the
placing of Adam in paradise, though it be here mentioned after an
account of the seventh day's rest: but what was said in general, chap.
i, 27, that God made man male and female is more distinctly related
here, God caused the sleep to fall on Adam, and made it a deep sleep,
that so the opening of his side might be no grievance to him: while he
knows no sin, God will take care he shall feel no pain. See note at
"ver. 21"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p21">23. And Adam said, this is now bone of my bones -
Probably it was revealed to Adam in a vision, when he was asleep, that
this lovely creature, now presented to him, was a piece of himself and
was to be his companion, and the wife of his covenant - In token of his
acceptance of her, he gave her a name, not peculiar to her, but common
to her sex; she shall be called woman, Isha, a She- man, differing from
man in sex only, not in nature; made of man, and joined to man.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p22">24. The sabbath and marriage were two ordinances
instituted in innocency, the former for the preservation of the church,
the latter for the preservation of mankind. It appears by <scripRef passage="Matt. xix. 4, 5" id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p22.1" parsed="|Matt|19|4|19|5" osisRef="Bible:Matt.19.4-Matt.19.5">Matt. xix, 4, 5</scripRef>, that it was God himself who said here, a man must leave all
his relations to cleave to his wife; but whether he spake it by Moses or
by Adam who spake, ver. 23 is uncertain: It should seem they are the
words of Adam in God's name, laying down this law to all his posterity.
The virtue of a divine ordinance, and the bonds of it, are stronger even
than those of nature. See how necessary it is that children should take
their parents consent with them in their marriage; and how unjust they
are to their parents, as well as undutiful, if they marry without it;
for they rob them of their right to them, and interest in them, and
alienate it to another fraudulently and unnaturally.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iii.ii-p23">25. They were both naked, they needed no cloaths for
defense against cold or heat, for neither could be injurious to them:
they needed none for ornament. Solomon in all his glory was not arrayed
like one of these. Nay, they needed none for decency, they were naked,
and had no reason to be ashamed. They knew not what shame was, so the
Chaldee reads it. Blushing is now the colour of virtue, but it was not
the colour of innocency.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="31.89%" prev="ii.ii.iii.ii" next="ii.ii.iv.i" id="ii.ii.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. III" id="ii.ii.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 3" progress="31.89%" prev="ii.ii.iv" next="ii.ii.iv.ii" id="ii.ii.iv.i">

<p id="ii.ii.iv.i-p1">The general contents of this chapter we have <scripRef passage="Rom. v. 12" id="ii.ii.iv.i-p1.1" parsed="|Rom|5|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.5.12">Rom. v, 12</scripRef>. By one man sin entered into the world, and death by sin,
and so death passed upon all men, for that all have sinned. More
particularly, we have here,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iv.i-p2">I. The innocent tempted, ver. 1-5.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iv.i-p3">II. The tempted transgressing, ver. 6, 7,
8.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iv.i-p4">III. The transgressors arraigned, ver. 9,
10.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iv.i-p5">IV. Upon their arraignment convicted, ver.
11-13.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iv.i-p6">V. Upon their conviction sentenced, ver.
14-19.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iv.i-p7">VI. After sentence, reprieved, ver. 20,
21.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.iv.i-p8">VII. Notwithstanding their reprieve,
execution in part done, ver. 22-24, and were it not for the gracious
intimations of redemption, they and all their race had been left to
despair.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 3" progress="31.90%" prev="ii.ii.iv.i" next="ii.ii.v" id="ii.ii.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p1">1, 2, 3, 4, 5. We have here an account of the temptation
wherewith Satan assaulted our first parents, and which proved fatal to
them. And here observe, (1.) The tempter, the devil in the shape of a
serpent. Multitudes of them fell; but this that attacked our first
parents, was surely the prince of the devils. Whether it was only the
appearance of a serpent, or a real serpent, acted and possessed by the
devil, is not certain. The devil chose to act his part in a serpent,
because it is a subtle creature. It is not improbable, that reason and
speech were then the known properties of the serpent. And therefore Eve
was not surprised at his reasoning and speaking, which otherwise she
must have been. (2.) That which the devil aimed at, was to persuade Eve
to eat forbidden fruit; and to do this, he took the same method that he
doth still.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p2">1. He questions whether it were a sin or
no, ver. 1,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p3">2. He denies that there was any danger in
it, ver. 4.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p4">3. He suggests much advantage by it, ver.
5. And these are his common topics. As to the advantage, he suits the
temptation to the pure state they were now in, proposing to them not any
carnal pleasure, but intellectual delights.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p5">1. Your eyes shall be opened - You shall
have much more of the power and pleasure of contemplation than now you
have; you shall fetch a larger compass in your intellectual views, and
see farther into things than now you do.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p6">2. You shall be as gods - As Elohim, mighty
gods, not only omniscient but omnipotent too:</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p7">3. You shall know good and evil - That is,
everything that is desirable to be known. To support this part of the
temptation, he abuseth the name given to this tree. 'Twas intended to
teach the practical knowledge of good and evil, that is, of duty and
disobedience, and it would prove the experimental knowledge of good and
evil, that is, of happiness and misery. But he perverts the sense of it,
and wrests it to their destruction, as if this tree would give them a
speculative notional knowledge of the natures, kinds, and originals of
good and evil. And,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p8">4. All this presently, In the day you eat
thereof - You will find a sudden and immediate change for the better.
See note at "ver. 1"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p9">6, 7, 8. Here we see what Eve's parley with the tempter
ended in: Satan at length gains his point. God tried the obedience of
our first parents by forbidding them the tree of knowledge, and Satan
doth as it were join issue with God, and in that very thing undertakes
to seduce them into a transgression; and here we find how he prevailed,
God permitting it for wise and holy ends. (1.) We have here the
inducements that moved them to transgress. The woman being deceived, was
ring-leader in the transgression, <scripRef passage="1 Tim. ii. 14" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p9.1" parsed="|1Tim|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.2.14">1
Tim. ii, 14</scripRef></p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p10">1. She saw that the tree was - It was said
of all the rest of the fruit trees wherewith the garden of Eden was
planted, that they were pleasant to the sight, and good for food.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p11">2. She imagined a greater benefit by this
tree than by any of the rest, that it was a tree not only not to be
dreaded, but to be desired to make one wise, and therein excelling all
the rest of the trees. This she saw, that is, she perceived and
understood it by what the devil had said to her. She gave also to her
husband with her - 'Tis likely he was not with her when she was tempted;
surely if he had, he would have interposed to prevent the sin; but he
came to her when she had eaten, and was prevailed with by her to eat
likewise. She gave it to him; persuading him with the same arguements
that the serpent had used with her; adding this to the rest, that she
herself had eaten of it, and found it so far from being deadly that it
was extremely pleasant and grateful. And he did eat - This implied the
unbelief of God's word, and confidence in the devil's; discontent with
his present state, and an ambition of the honour which comes not from
God. He would be both his own carver, and his own master, would have
what he pleased, and do what he pleased; his sin was in one word
disobedience, <scripRef passage="Rom. v. 19" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Rom|5|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.5.19">Rom. v, 19</scripRef>, disobedience to a plain, easy and express command, which he
knew to be a command of trial. He sins against light and love, the
clearest light and the dearest love that ever sinner sinned against. But
the greatest aggravation of his sin was, that he involved all his
posterity in sin and ruin by it. He could not but know that he stood as
a public person, and that his disobedience would be fatal to all his
seed; and if so, it was certainly both the greatest treachery and the
greatest cruelty that ever was. Shame and fear seized the criminals,
these came into the world along with sin, and still attend it. The Eyes
of them both were opened - The eyes of their consciences; their hearts
smote them for what they had done Now, when it was too late, they saw
the happiness they were fallen from, and the misery they were fallen
into. They saw God provoked, his favour forfeited, his image lost; they
felt a disorder in their own spirits, which they had never before been
conscious of; they saw a law in their members warring against the law of
their minds, and captivating them both to sin and wrath; they saw that
they were naked, that is, that they were stripped, deprived of all the
honours and joys of their paradise state, and exposed to all the
miseries that might justly be expected from an angry God; laid open to
the contempt and reproach of heaven and earth, and their own
consciences. And they sewed or platted fig leaves together, and, to
cover, at least, part of their shame one from another, made themselves
aprons. See here what is commonly the folly of those that have sinned:
they are more solicitous to save their credit before men, than to obtain
their pardon from God. And they heard the voice of the Lord God walking
in the garden in the cool of the day - Tis supposed he came in a human
shape; in no other similitude than that wherein they had seen him when
he put them into paradise; for he came to convince and humble them, not
to amaze and terrify them. He came not immediately from heaven in their
view as afterwards on Mount Sinai, but he came in the garden, as one
that was still willing to be familiar with them. He came walking, not
riding upon the wings of the wind, but walking deliberately, as one slow
to anger. He came in the cool of the day, not in the night, when all
fears are doubly fearful; nor did he come suddenly upon them, but they
heard his voice at some distance, giving them notice of his coming; and
probably it was a still small voice, like that in which he came to
inquire after Elijah. And they hid themselves from the presence of the
Lord God - A sad change! Before they had sinned, if they heard the voice
of the Lord God coming towards them, they would have run to meet him,
but now God was become a terror to them, and then no marvel they were
become a terror to themselves. See note at "ver. 6"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p12">9. Where art thou? - This enquiry after Adam may be
looked upon as a gracious pursuit in order to his recovery. If God had
not called to him to reduce him, his condition had been as desperate as
that of fallen angels.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p13">10. I heard thy voice in the garden: and I was afraid -
Adam was afraid because he was naked; not only unarmed, and therefore
afraid to contend with God, but unclothed and therefore afraid so much
as to appear before him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p14">11. Who told thee that thou wast naked? - That is, how
camest thou to be sensible of thy nakedness as thy shame? Hast thou
eaten of the tree? - Tho' God knows all our sins, yet he will know them
from us, and requires from us an ingenuous confession of them, not that
he may be informed, but that we may be humbled. Whereof I commanded thee
not to eat of it, I thy maker, I thy master, I thy benefactor, I
commanded thee to the contrary. Sin appears most plain and most sinful
in the glass of the commandment.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p15">13. What is this that thou hast done? - Wilt thou own thy
fault? Neither of them does this fully. Adam lays all the blame upon his
wife: She gave me of the tree - Nay, he not only lays the blame upon his
wife, but tacitly on God himself. The woman thou gavest me, and gavest
to be with me as my companion, she gave me of the tree. Eve lays all the
blame upon the serpent; the serpent beguiled me. The prisoners being
found guilty by their own confession, besides the infallible knowledge
of the Judge, and nothing material being offered in arrest of judgment,
God immediately proceeds to pass sentence, and in these verses he begins
(where the sin began) with the serpent. God did not examine the serpent,
nor ask him what he had done, but immediately sentenced him, (1.)
Because he was already convicted of rebellion against God. (2.) Because
he was to be forever excluded from pardon; and why should any thing be
said to convince and humble him, who was to find no place for
repentance?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p16">14. To testify a displeasure against sin, God fastens a
curse upon the serpent, Thou art cursed above all cattle - Even the
creeping things, when God made them, were blessed of him, chap. i, 22,
but sin turned the blessing into a curse. Upon thy belly shalt thou go -
No longer upon feet, or half erect, but thou shalt crawl along, thy
belly cleaving to the earth. Dust thou shalt eat - Which signifies a
base and despicable condition.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p17">15. And I will put enmity between thee and the woman -
The inferior creatures being made for man, it was a curse upon any of
them to be turned against man, and man against them. And this is part of
the serpent's curse.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p18">1. A perpetual reproach is fastened upon
him. Under the cover of the serpent he is here sentenced to be, (1.)
Degraded and accursed of God. It is supposed, pride was the sin that
turned angels into devils, which is here justly punished by a great
variety of mortifications couched under the mean circumstances of a
serpent, crawling on his belly, and licking the dust. (2.) Detested and
abhorred of all mankind: even those that are really seduced into his
interest, yet profess a hatred of him. (3.) Destroyed and ruined at last
by the great Redeemer, signified by the bruising of his head; his subtle
politics shall be all baffled, his usurped power entirely crushed.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p19">2. A perpetual quarrel is here commenced
between the kingdom of God, and the kingdom of the devil among men; war
proclaimed between the seed of the woman, and the seed of the serpent, <scripRef passage="Rev. xii. 7" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Rev|12|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.12.7">Rev. xii, 7</scripRef>. It is the fruit of this enmity, (1.) That there is a
continual conflict between God's people and him. Heaven and hell can
never be reconciled, no more can Satan and a sanctified soul. (2.) That
there is likewise a continual struggle between the wicked and the good.
And all the malice of persecutors against the people of God is the fruit
of this enmity, which will continue while there is a godly man on this
side heaven, and a wicked man on this side hell.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p20">3. A gracious promise is here made of
Christ as the deliverer of fallen man from the power of Satan. By faith
in this promise, our first parents, and the patriarchs before the flood,
were justified and saved; and to this promise, and the benefit of it,
instantly serving God day and night they hoped to come. Notice is here
given them of three things concerning Christ. (1.) His incarnation, that
he should be the seed of the woman. (2.) His sufferings and death,
pointed at in Satan's bruising his heel, that is, his human nature. (3.)
His victory over Satan thereby. Satan had now trampled upon the woman,
and insulted over her; but the seed of the woman should be raised up in
the fulness of time to avenge her quarrel, and to trample upon him, to
spoil him, to lead him captive, and to triumph over him, <scripRef passage="Colossians ii. 15" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p20.1" parsed="|Col|2|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.2.15">Colossians ii, 15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p21">16. We have here the sentence past upon the woman; she is
condemned to a state of sorrow and a state of subjection: proper
punishments of a sin in which she had gratified her pleasure and her
pride. (1.) She is here put into a state of sorrow; one particular of
which only is instanced in, that in bringing forth children, but it
includes all those impressions of grief and fear which the mind of that
tender sex is most apt to receive, and all the common calamities which
they are liable to. It is God that multiplies our sorrows, I will do it:
God, as a righteous Judge, doth it, which ought to silence us under all
our sorrows; as many as they are we have deserved them all, and more:
nay, God as a tender Father doth it for our necessary correction, that
we may be humbled for sin, and weaned from it. (2.) She is here put into
a state of subjection: the whole sex, which by creation was equal with
man, is for sin made inferior.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p22">17. Because thou hast hearkened to the voice of thy wife
- He excused the fault, by laying it on his wife, but God doth not admit
the excuse; tho' it was her fault to persuade him to eat it, it was his
fault to hearken to her. Cursed is the ground for thy sake - And the
effect of that curse is, Thorns and thistles shall it bring forth unto
thee - The ground or earth, by the sin of man, is made subject to
vanity, the several parts of it being not so serviceable to man's
comfort and happiness, as they were when they were made. Fruitfulness
was its blessing for man's service, chap. i, 11-29, and now barrenness
was its curse for man's punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p23">19. In the sweat of thy face shalt thou eat bread - His
business before he sinned was a constant pleasure to him; but now his
labour shall be a weariness. Unto dust shalt thou return - Thy body
shall be forsaken by thy soul, and become itself a lump of dust, and
then it shall be lodged in the grave, and mingle with the dust of the
earth.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p24">20. God having named the man, and called him Adam, which
signifies red earth, he in farther token of dominion named the woman,
and called her Eve - That is, life. Adam bears the name of the dying
body, Eve of the living soul. The reason of the name is here given, some
think by Moses the historian, others by Adam himself, because she was -
That is, was to be the mother of all living. He had called her Isha,
woman, before, as a wife; here he calls her Evah, life, as a mother.
Now,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p25">1. If this was done by divine direction, it
was an instance of God's favour, and, like the new naming of Abraham and
Sarah, it was a seal of the covenant, and an assurance to them, that
notwithstanding their sin, he had not reversed that blessing wherewith
he had blessed them, Be fruitful and multiply: it was likewise a
confirmation of the promise now made, that the seed of the woman, of
this woman, should break the serpent's head.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p26">2. If Adam did of himself, it was an
instance of his faith in the word of God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p27">21. These coats of skin had a significancy. The beasts
whose skins they were, must be slain; slain before their eyes to shew
them what death is. And probably 'tis supposed they were slain for
sacrifice, to typify the great sacrifice which in the latter end of the
world should be offered once for all. Thus the first thing that died was
a sacrifice, or Christ in a figure.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p28">22. Behold, the man is become as one of us, to know good
and evil - See what he has got, what advantages, by eating forbidden
fruit! This is said to humble them, and to bring them to a sense of
their sin and folly, that seeing themselves thus wretchedly deceived by
following the devil's counsel, they might henceforth pursue the
happiness God offers, in the way he prescribes.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p29">23. He sent him forth - Bid him go out, told him he
should no longer occupy and enjoy that garden; but he was not willing to
part with it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p30">24. God drove him out - This signified the exclusion of
him and his guilty race from that communion with God which was the bliss
and glory of paradise. But whether did he send him when he turned him
out of Eden? He might justly have chased him out of the world, <scripRef passage="Job xviii. 18" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p30.1" parsed="|Job|18|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.18.18">Job xviii, 18</scripRef>, but he only chased him out of the garden: he might justly
have cast him down to hell, as the angels that sinned were, when they
were shut out from the heavenly paradise, <scripRef passage="2 Pet. ii. 4" id="ii.ii.iv.ii-p30.2" parsed="|2Pet|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.2.4">2 Pet. ii,
4</scripRef>, but man was only sent to till the ground out of which he
was taken. He was only sent to a place of toil, not to a place of
torment. He was sent to the ground, not to the grave; to the work-
house, not to the dungeon, not to the prison-house; to hold the plough,
not to drag the chain: his tilling the ground would be recompensed by
his eating its fruits; and his converse with the earth, whence he was
taken, was improveable to good purposes, to keep him humble, and to mind
him of his latter end. Observe then, That though our first parents were
excluded from the privileges of their state of innocency, yet they were
not abandoned to despair; God's thoughts of love designing them for a
second state of probation upon new terms. And he placed at the east of
the garden of Eden, a detachment of cherubim, armed with a dreadful and
irresistible power, represented by flaming swords which turned every
way, on that side the garden which lay next to the place whither Adam
was sent, to keep the way that led to the tree of life.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="32.20%" prev="ii.ii.iv.ii" next="ii.ii.v.i" id="ii.ii.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. IV" id="ii.ii.v-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 4" progress="32.20%" prev="ii.ii.v" next="ii.ii.v.ii" id="ii.ii.v.i">

<p id="ii.ii.v.i-p1">In this chapter we have both the world and the church in
Adam's family, and a specimen of the character and state of both in all
ages. As all mankind were represented in Adam, so that great distinction
of mankind into the children of God and the children of the wicked one,
was here represented in Cain and Abel; and an early instance of the
enmity between the seed of the woman and the seed of the serpent. We
have here,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.v.i-p2">I. The birth, names, and callings of Cain
and Abel, ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.v.i-p3">II. Their religion, and different success
in it, ver. 3, 4, and part of ver. 5.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.v.i-p4">III. Cain's anger at God, and the reproof
of him for that anger, ver. 5, 6, 7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.v.i-p5">IV. Cain's murder of his brother, and the
process against him for that murder. The murder committed, ver. 8. The
proceedings against him. (1.) His arraignment, ver. 9, former part. (2.)
His plea, ver. 9. latter part. (3.) His conviction, ver. 10. (4.) The
sentence passed upon him, ver. 11, 12. (5.) His complaint against the
sentence, ver. 13, 14. (6.) The ratification of the sentence, ver. 15.
(7.) The execution of the sentence, ver. 15, 16.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.v.i-p6">V. The family and posterity of Cain, ver.
17-24.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.v.i-p7">VI. The birth of another son and grandson
of Adam, ver. 25, 26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 4" progress="32.22%" prev="ii.ii.v.i" next="ii.ii.vi" id="ii.ii.v.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p1">1. Adam and Eve had many sons and daughters, chap. v, 4.
But Cain and Abel seem to have been the two eldest. Cain signifies
possession; for Eve when she bare him said with joy and thankfulness,
and great expectation, I have gotten a man from the Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p2">2. Abel signifies vanity. The name given to this son is
put upon the whole race, <scripRef passage="Psalm xxxix. 5" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Ps|39|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.39.5">Psalm xxxix,
5</scripRef>. Every man is at his best estate vanity; Abel, vanity. He
chose that employment which did most befriend contemplation and
devotion, for that hath been looked upon as the advantage of a pastoral
life. Moses and David kept sheep, and in their solitudes conversed with
God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p3">3. In process of time - At the end of days, either at the
end of the year when they kept their feast of in-gathering, or at the
end of the days of the week, the seventh day; at some set time Cain and
Abel brought to Adam, as the priest of the family, each of them an
offering to the Lord; for which we have reason to think there was a
divine appointment given to Adam, as a token of God's favour
notwithstanding their apostacy.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p4">4. And the Lord God had respect to Abel and to his
offering, and shewed his acceptance of it, probably by fire from heaven
but to Cain and to his offering he had not respect. We are sure there
was a good reason for this difference: that Governor of the world,
though an absolute sovereign, doth not act arbitrarily in dispensing his
smiles and frowns.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p5">1. There was a difference in the characters
of the persons offering: Cain was a wicked man, but Abel was a righteous
man, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 35" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Matt|23|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.35">Matt. xxiii, 35</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p6">2. There was a difference in the offerings
they brought. Abel's was a more excellent sacrifice than Cain's; Cain's
was only a sacrifice of acknowledgment offered to the Creator; the meat-
offerings of the fruit of the ground were no more: but Abel brought a
sacrifice of atonement, the blood whereof was shed in order to
remission, thereby owning himself a sinner, deprecating God's wrath, and
imploring his favour in a Mediator. But the great difference was, Abel
offered in faith, and Cain did not. Abel offered with an eye to God's
will as his rule, and in dependence upon the promise of a Redeemer. But
Cain did not offer in faith, and so it turned into sin to him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p7">5. And Cain was wroth, and his countenance fell - Not so
much out of grief as malice and rage. His sullen churlish countenance,
and down-look, betrayed his passionate resentment.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p8">7. If thou dost well, shalt thou not be accepted? -
Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p9">1. If thou hadst done well, as thy brother
did, thou shouldest have been accepted as he was. God is no respecter of
persons; so that if we come short of acceptance with him, the fault is
wholly our own. This will justify God in the destruction of sinners, and
will aggravate their ruin. There is not a damned sinner in hell, but if
he had done well, as he might have done, had been a glorified saint in
heaven. Every mouth will shortly be stopt with this. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p10">2. If now thou do well: if thou repent of
thy sin, reform thy heart and life, and bring thy sacrifice in a better
manner; thou shalt yet be accepted. See how early the gospel was
preached, and the benefit of it here offered even to one of the chief of
sinners. He sets before him death and a curse; but, if not well - Seeing
thou didst not do well, not offer in faith, and in a right manner, sin
lieth at the door - That is, sin only hinders thy acceptance. All this
considered, Cain had no reason to be angry with his brother, but at
himself only. Unto thee shall be his desire - He shall continue in
respect to thee as an elder brother, and thou, as the first-born, shall
rule over him as much as ever. God's acceptance of Abel's offering did
not transfer the birth-right to him, (which Cain was jealous of) nor put
upon him that dignity, and power, which is said to belong to it, chap.
xlix, 3.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p11">8. And Cain talked with Abel his brother - The Chaldee
paraphrast adds, that Cain, when they were in discourse, maintained
there was no judgment to come, and that when Abel spoke in defense of
the truth, Cain took that occasion to fall upon him. The scripture tells
us the reason wherefore he slew him, because his own works were evil,
and his brother's righteous; so that herein he shewed himself to be a
child of the devil, as being an enemy to all righteousness. Observe, the
first that dies is a saint, the first that went to the grave, went to
heaven. God would secure to himself the first fruits, the first born to
the dead, that first opened the womb into another world.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p12">9. And the Lord said unto Cain, Where is Abel thy
brother? - God knew him to be guilty; yet he asks him, that he might
draw from him a confession of his crime; for those who would be
justified before God, must accuse themselves. And he said, I know not -
Thus in Cain the devil was both a murderer, and a liar from the
beginning. Am I my Brother's keeper? - Sure he is old enough to take
care of himself, nor did I ever take charge of him. Art not thou his
keeper? If he be missing, on thee be the blame, and not on me, who never
undertook to keep him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p13">10. And he said, What hast thou done? - Thou thinkest to
conceal it, but the evidence against thee is clear and uncontestable,
the voice of thy brother's blood crieth - He speaks as if the blood
itself were both witness and prosecutor, because God's own knowledge
testified against him, and God's own justice demanded satisfaction. The
blood is said to cry from the ground, the earth, which is said, ver. 11,
to open her mouth to receive his brother's blood from his hand. The
earth did as it were blush to see her own face stained with such blood;
and therefore opened her mouth to hide that which she could not
hinder.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p14">11. And now art thou cursed from the earth -</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p15">1. He is cursed, separated to all evil,
laid under the wrath of God, as it is revealed from heaven against all
ungodliness and unrighteousness of men.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p16">2. He is cursed from the earth. Thence the
cry came up to God, thence the curse came up to Cain. God could have
taken vengeance by an immediate stroke from heaven: but he chose to make
the earth the avenger of blood; to continue him upon the earth, and not
presently to cut him off; and yet to make even that his curse. That part
of it which fell to his share, and which he had the occupation of, was
made unfruitful, by the blood of Abel. Besides, A fugitive and a
vagabond shalt thou be in the earth. By this he was here condemned, to
perpetual disgrace and reproach, and to perpetual disquietment and
horror in his own mind. His own guilty conscience should haunt him where
ever he went. Now to justify his complaint, Observe his descants upon
the sentence.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p17">1. He sees himself excluded by it from the
favour of his God; and concludes, that being cursed, he was hid from
God's face, and that is indeed the true nature of God's curse; damned
sinners find it so, to whom it is said, Depart from me ye cursed. Those
are cursed indeed that are forever shut out from God's love and care,
and from all hopes of his grace.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p18">2. He sees himself expelled from all the
comforts of this life; and concludes, ver. 14. Thou hast driven me out
this day from the face of the earth - As good have no place on earth as
not have a settled place. Better rest in the grave than not rest at all.
And from thy face shall I be hid - Shut out of the church, not admitted
to come with the sons of God to present himself before the Lord. And it
shall come to pass that every one that finds me shall slay me - Wherever
he wanders he goes in peril of his life. There were none alive but his
near relations, yet even of them he is justly afraid, who had himself
been so barbarous to his own brother.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p19">15. Whosoever slayeth Cain vengeance shall be taken on
him seven- fold - God having said in Cain's case Vengeance is mine, I
will repay; it had been a daring usurpation for any man to take the
sword out of God's hand. And the Lord set a mark upon Cain - To
distinguish him from the rest of mankind. What the mark was, God has not
told us: therefore the conjectures of men are vain.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p20">16. And Cain went out from the presence of the Lord, and
dwelt on the east of Eden - Somewhere distant from the place were Adam
and his religious family resided: distinguishing himself and his
accursed generation from the holy seed; in the land of Nod - That is, of
shaking or trembling, because of the continual restlessness of his
spirit. Those that depart from God cannot find rest any where else. When
Cain went out from the presence of the Lord, he never rested after.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p21">17. And he builded a city - In token of a settled
separation from the church of God. And here is an account of his
posterity, at least the heirs of his family, for seven generations. His
son was Enoch, of the same name, but not of the same character with that
holy man that walked with God. The names of more of his posterity are
mentioned, and but just mentioned, as those of the holy seed, chap. v,
1-32. They are numbered in haste, as not valued or delighted in, in
comparison with God's children.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p22">19. And Lamech took two wives - It was one of the
degenerate race of Cain who first transgressed that original law of
marriage, that two only should be one flesh.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p23">1. Jabal was a famous shepherd; he
delighted much in keeping cattle, and was so happy in devising methods
of doing it to the best advantage, and instructing others in them, that
the shepherds of those times, nay, the shepherds of after-times, called
him Father; or perhaps his children after him, being brought up to the
same employment: the family was a family of shepherds.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p24">2. Jubal was a famous musician, and
particularly an organist, and the first that gave rules for that noble
art or science of music. When Jabal had set them in a way to be rich,
Jubal put them in a way to be merry. From Jubal probably the Jubilee
trumpet was so called; for the best music was that which proclaimed
liberty and redemption.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p25">22. From Tubal-Cain, probably the Heathen Vulcan came.
Why Naamah is particularly named, we know not: probably they did, who
lived when Moses wrote.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p26">23. This passage is extremely obscure. We know not whom
he slew, or on what occasion: neither what ground he had to be so
confident of the Divine protection.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p27">25. This is the first mention of Adam in the story of
this chapter. No question the murder of Abel, and the impenitency and
apostacy of Cain, were a very great grief to him and Eve, and the more
because their own wickedness did now correct them, and their backsliding
did reprove them. Their folly had given sin and death entrance into the
world, and now they smarted by it, being by means thereof deprived of
both their sons in one day, chap. xxvii, 45. When parents are grieved by
their children's wickedness, they should take occasion from thence to
lament that corruption of nature which was derived from them, and which
is the root of bitterness. But here we have that which was a relief to
our first parents in their affliction, namely, God gave them to see the
rebuilding of their family which was sorely shaken and weakened by that
sad event. For, they saw their seed, another instead of Abel. And Adam
called his name Seth - That is, Set, settled or placed, because in his
seed mankind should continue to the end of time.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.v.ii-p28">26. And to Seth was born a son called Enos, which is the
general name for all men, and speaks the weakness, frailty, and misery
of man's state. Then began men to call upon the name of the Lord -
Doubtless God's name was called upon before, but now,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p29">1. The worshippers of God began to stir up
themselves to do more in religion than they had done; perhaps not more
than had been done at first, but more than had been done since the
defection of Cain. Now men began to worship God, not only in their
closets and families, but in public and solemn assemblies.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.v.ii-p30">2. The worshippers of God began to
distinguish themselves: so the margin reads it. Then began men to be
called by the name of the Lord, or, to call themselves by it. Now Cain
and those that had deserted religion had built a city, and begun to
declare for irreligion, and called themselves the sons of men. Those
that adhered to God began to declare for him and his worship, and called
themselves the sons of God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="32.44%" prev="ii.ii.v.ii" next="ii.ii.vi.i" id="ii.ii.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. V" id="ii.ii.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 5" progress="32.44%" prev="ii.ii.vi" next="ii.ii.vi.ii" id="ii.ii.vi.i">

<p id="ii.ii.vi.i-p1">This chapter is the only authentic history extant of the
first age of the world from the creation to the flood, containing
(according to the Hebrew text) 1656 years. The genealogy here recorded
is inserted briefly in the pedigree of our saviour, <scripRef passage="Luke iii. 36, 37" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p1.1" parsed="|Luke|3|36|3|37" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3.36-Luke.3.37">Luke iii, 36, 37</scripRef>. and is of great use to shew that Christ was the seed of the
woman, that was promised. We have here an account,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p2">I. Concerning Adam, ver. 1-5.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p3">II. Seth, ver. 6-8.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p4">III. Enos, ver. 9-11.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p5">IV. Cainan, ver. 12-14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p6">V. Mahalaleel, ver. 15-17.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p7">VI. Jared, ver. 18-20.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p8">VII. Enoch, ver. 21-24.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p9">VIII. Mathuselah, ver. 25-27.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p10">IX. Lamech and his son Noah, ver.
28-32.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vi.i-p11">1. The first words of the chapter are the
title of argument of the whole chapter; it is the book of the
generations of Adam - It is the list or catalogue of the posterity of
Adam, not of all, but only of the holy seed, and of whom as concerning
the flesh Christ came; the names, ages, and deaths of those that were
the successors of the first Adam in the custody of the promise, and the
ancestors of the second Adam.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 5" progress="32.45%" prev="ii.ii.vi.i" next="ii.ii.vii" id="ii.ii.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p1">1, 2. Where we have a brief rehearsal of what was before
at large related concerning the creation of man. This is what we have
need frequently to hear of, and carefully to acquaint ourselves with.
Observe here.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p2">1. That God created man. Man is not his own
maker, therefore he must not be his own master; but the author of his
being must be the director of his motions, and the center of them.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p3">2. That there was a day in which God
created man, he was not from eternity, but of yesterday; he was not the
first-born, but the junior of the creation.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p4">3. That God made him in his own likeness,
righteous and holy, and therefore undoubtedly happy; man's nature
resembled the divine nature more than that of any of the creatures of
this lower world.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p5">4. That God created them male and female,
ver. 2, for their mutual comfort, as well as for the preservation and
increase of their kind. Adam and Eve were both made immediately by the
hand of God, both made in God's likeness; and therefore between the
sexes there is not that great difference and inequality which some
imagine.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p6">5. That God blessed them. It is usual for
parents to bless their children, so God the common Father blessed his;
but earthly parents can only beg a blessing, it is God's prerogative to
command it. It refers chiefly to the blessing of increase, not excluding
other blessings.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p7">2. He called their name Adam - He gave this name both to
the man and the woman. Being at first one by nature, and afterwards one
by marriage; it was fit they should both have the same name, in token of
their union. See note - part two at - "ver. 1"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p8">3. Seth was born in the 130th year of Adam's life, and
probably the murder of Abel was not long before. Many other sons and
daughters were born to Adam besides Cain and Abel before this; but no
notice is taken of them, because an honourable mention must be made of
his name only, in whose loins Christ and the church were. But that which
is most observable here concerning Seth, is, that Adam begat him in his
own likeness after his image - Adam was made in the image of God; but
when he was fallen and corrupted, he begat a son in his own image,
sinful and defiled, frail and mortal, and miserable like himself; not
only a man like himself, consisting of body and soul; but a sinner like
himself, guilty and obnoxious, degenerate and corrupt. He was conceived
and born in sin, <scripRef passage="Psalm li. 5" id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|51|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.51.5">Psalm li, 5</scripRef>. This was Adam's own likeness, the reverse of that Divine
likeness in which Adam was made; but having lost it himself he could not
convey it to his seed.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p9">5. In the day Adam ate forbidden fruit, he became mortal,
he began to die; his whole life after was but a forfeited condemned
life, nay it was a wasting dying life; he was not only like a criminal
sentenced, but as one already crucified, that dies slowly and by
degrees. 6-19. We have here all that the Holy Ghost thought fit to leave
upon record concerning five of the patriarchs before the flood, Seth,
Enos, Cainan, Mahalaleel, and Jared. There is nothing observable
concerning any of those particularly, tho' we have reason to think they
were men of eminency, both for prudence and piety: But in general,
observe how largely and expressly their generations are recorded. We are
told how long they lived that lived in God's fear, and when they died,
that died in his favour; but as for others it is no matter: the memory
of the just is blessed, but the name of the wicked shall rot. That which
is especially observable, is, that they all lived very long; not one of
them died 'till he had seen the revolution of almost eight hundred
years, and some of them much longer; a great while for an immortal soul
to be imprisoned in an house of clay. The present life surely was not to
them such a burden as commonly it is now, else they would have been
weary of it; nor was the future life so clearly revealed then, as it is
now under the gospel, else they would have been impatient to remove it.
Some natural causes may be assigned for their long life in those first
ages. It is very probable that the earth was more fruitful, the products
of it more strengthening, the air more healthful, and the influences of
the heavenly bodies more benign before the flood than they were after.
Though man was driven out of paradise, yet the earth itself was then
paradisaical; a garden in comparison with its present state: and some
think, that their knowledge of the creatures and their usefulness both,
for their food and medicine, together with their sobriety and
temperance, contributed much to it; yet we do not find that those who
were intemperate, as many were, <scripRef passage="Luke xvii. 27" id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Luke|17|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17.27">Luke xvii, 27</scripRef>, as short-lived as temperate men generally are now. It must
therefore chiefly be resolved into the power and providence of God; he
prolonged their lives, both for the more speedy replenishing of the
earth, and for the more effectual preservation of the knowledge of God
and religion, then when there was no written word, but tradition was the
channel of its conveyance. All the patriarchs here (except Noah) were
born before Adam died, so that from him they might receive a full
account of the creation, paradise, the fall, the promise, and those
divine precepts which concerned religious worship and a religious life:
and if any mistake arose, they might have recourse to him while he
lived, as to an oracle, for the rectifying of it, and after his death to
Methuselah, and others that had conversed with him; so great was the
care of Almighty God to preserve in his church the knowledge of his
will, and the purity of his worship. See note at "ver. 6"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p10">22. And Enoch walked with God after he begat Methuselah -
To walk with God, is to set God always before us, and to act as those
that are always under his eye. It is to live a life of communion with
God, both in ordinances and providences; it is to make God's word our
rule, and his glory our end, in all our actions; it is to make it our
constant care and endeavour in every thing to please God, and in nothing
to offend him; it is to comply with his will, to concur with his
designs, and to be workers together with him. He walked with God after
he begat Methuselah, which intimates, that he did not begin to be
eminent for piety 'till about that time.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p11">24. He was not, for God took him - That is, as it is
explained, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 5" id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Heb|11|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.5">Heb. xi, 5</scripRef>, he was translated that he should not see death; and was not
found, because God had translated him. But why did God take him so soon?
Surely because the world, which was now grown corrupt, was not worthy of
him. Because his work was done, and done the sooner for his minding it
so closely. He was not, for God took him - He was not any longer in this
world: it was not the period of his being, but of his being here. He was
not found; so the apostle explains it from the seventy; not found by his
friends, who sought him, as the sons of the prophets sought Elijah, <scripRef passage="2 Kings ii. 17" id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p11.2" parsed="|2Kgs|2|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.2.17">2 Kings ii, 17</scripRef>. God took him body and soul to himself in the heavenly
paradise, by the ministry of angels, as afterwards he took Elijah. He
was changed, as those saints shall be that will be found alive at
Christ's second coming.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p12">25. Methuselah signifies, He dies, there is a sending
forth, viz. of the deluge, which came the very year that Methuselah
died. If his name was so intended, it was a fair warning to a careless
world long before the judgment came. However, this is observable, that
the longest liver that ever was, carried death in his name, that he
might be minded of its coming surely, tho' it came slowly. He lived nine
hundred sixty and nine years, the longest we read of that ever any man
lived on earth, and yet he died: the longest liver must die at last.
Neither youth nor age will discharge from that war, for that is the end
of all men: none can challenge life by long prescription, nor make that
a plea against the arrests of death. 'Tis commonly supposed, that
Methuselah died a little before the flood; the Jewish writers say, seven
days before, referring to chap. vii, 10, and that he was taken away from
the evil to come.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p13">29. This same shall comfort us concerning our work and
toil of our hands, because of the ground which the Lord hath cursed -
Very probably there were some prophecies that went before of him, as a
person that should be wonderfully serviceable to his generation.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vi.ii-p14">32. And Noah begat Shem, Ham, and Japheth - These Noah
begat (the eldest of these) when he was six hundred years old. It should
seem that Japheth was the eldest, chap. x, 21, but Shem is put first,
because on him the covenant was entailed, as appears by chap. ix, 26,
where God is called the Lord God of Shem. To him 'tis probable the
birthright was given, and from him 'tis certain both Christ the head,
and the church the body, were to descend; therefore he is called Shem,
which signifies a name, because in his posterity the name of God should
always remain, 'till He should come out of his loins, whose name is
above every name; so that in putting Shem first, Christ was in effect
put first, who in all things must have the pre-eminence. For the glory
of God's justice, and for warning to a wicked world, before the history
of the ruin of the old world we have a full account of its degeneracy,
its apostacy from God, and rebellion against him. The destroying of it
was an act not of absolute sovereignty, but of necessary justice for the
maintaining of the honour of God's government.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="32.62%" prev="ii.ii.vi.ii" next="ii.ii.vii.i" id="ii.ii.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. VI" id="ii.ii.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 6" progress="32.62%" prev="ii.ii.vii" next="ii.ii.vii.ii" id="ii.ii.vii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.vii.i-p1">In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vii.i-p2">I. The abounding iniquity of that wicked
world, ver. 1-5. and ver. 11, 12.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vii.i-p3">II. God's just resentment of that iniquity,
and his holy resolution to punish it, ver. 6, 7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.vii.i-p4">III. The special favour of God to his
servant Noah. (1.) In the character given of him, ver. 8, 9, 10. (2.) In
the communication of God's purpose to him, ver. 13-17. (3.) In the
directions he gave him to make an ark for his own safety, ver. 14, 15,
16. (4.) In the employing of him for the preservation of the rest of the
creatures, ver. 18, 19, 20, 21. Lastly, Noah's obedience to the
instructions given him, ver. 22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 6" progress="32.63%" prev="ii.ii.vii.i" next="ii.ii.viii" id="ii.ii.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p1">1. Men began to multiply upon the face of the earth -
This was the effect of the blessing, chap. i, 28, and yet man's
corruption so abused this blessing, that it turned into a curse.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p2">2. The sons of God - Those who were called by the name of
the Lord, and called upon that name, married the daughters of men -
Those that were profane, and strangers to God. The posterity of Seth did
not keep to themselves as they ought, but intermingled with the race of
Cain: they took them wives of all that they chose - They chose only by
the eye: They saw that they were fair - Which was all they looked
at.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p3">3. My spirit shall not always strive with man - The
spirit then strove by Noah's preaching, <scripRef passage="1 Pet. iii. 19" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|1Pet|3|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.3.19">1 Pet. iii, 19</scripRef>, and by inward checks, but 'twas in vain with the most of
men; therefore saith God, he shall not always strive, for that he also
is flesh - Incurably corrupt and sensual, so that 'tis labour lost to
strive with him. He also, that is, all, one as well as another; they are
all sunk into the mire of flesh. Yet his days shall be an hundred and
twenty years - So long will I defer the judgment they deserve, and give
them space to prevent it by their repentance and reformation. Justice
said, cut them down; but mercy interceded, Lord, let them alone this
year also; and so far mercy prevailed, that a reprieve was obtained for
six score years.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p4">4. There were giants, and men of renown - They carried
all before them,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p5">1. With their great bulk, as the sons of
Anak, <scripRef passage="Num. xiii. 33" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Num|13|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.13.33">Num. xiii, 33</scripRef>, and,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p6">2. With their great name, as the king of
Assyria, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxxvii. 11" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Isa|37|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.37.11">Isaiah xxxvii,
11</scripRef>. Thus armed, they daringly insulted the rights of all their
neighbours, and trampled upon all that is just and sacred.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p7">5. And God saw that the wickedness of man was great in
the earth - Abundance of sin was committed in all places, by all sorts
of people: and those sins in their own nature most gross and heinous,
and provoking: and committed daringly, with a defiance of heaven. And
that every imagination of the thoughts of his heart was only evil
continually - A sad sight, and very offensive to God's holy eye. This
was the bitter root, the corrupt spring: all the violence and
oppression, all the luxury and wantonness that was in the world,
proceeded from the corruption of nature; lust conceives them, <scripRef passage="James i. 15" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Jas|1|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.1.15">James i, 15</scripRef>, see <scripRef passage="Matt. xv. 19" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Matt|15|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.15.19">Matt. xv, 19</scripRef>. The heart was evil, deceitful and desperately wicked; the
principles were corrupt, and the habits and dispositions evil. The
thoughts of the heart were so. Thought is sometimes taken for the
settled judgment, and that was biased and misled; sometimes for the
workings of the fancy, and those were always either vain or vile. The
imagination of the thought of the heart was so, that is, their designs
and devices were wicked. They did not do evil only through carelessness,
but deliberately and designedly, contriving how to do mischief. 'Twas
bad indeed, for it was only evil, continually evil, and every
imagination was so. There was no good to be found among them, no not at
any time: the stream of sin was full and strong, and constant; and God
saw it. Here is God's resentment of man's wickedness. He did not see it
as an unconcerned spectator, but as one injured and affronted by it; he
saw it as a tender father sees the folly and stubbornness of a
rebellious and disobedient child, which not only angers but grieves him,
and makes him wish he had been written childless.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p8">6. And it repented the Lord that he had made man upon the
earth - That he had made a creature of such noble powers, and had put
him on this earth, which he built and furnished on purpose to be a
comfortable habitation for him; and it grieved him at his heart - These
are expressions after the manner of men, and must be understood so as
not to reflect upon God's immutability or felicity. It doth not speak
any passion or uneasiness in God, nothing can create disturbance to the
eternal mind; but it speaks his just and holy displeasure against sin
and sinners: neither doth it speak any change of God's mind; for with
him there is no variableness; but it speaks a change of his way. When
God had made man upright, he rested and was refreshed, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxi. 17" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Exod|31|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.31.17">Exod. xxxi, 17</scripRef>. and his way towards him was such as shewed him well pleased
with the work of his own hands; but now man was apostatized, he could
not do otherwise, but shew himself displeased; so that the change was in
man, not in God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p9">7. I will destroy man - The original word is very
significant. I will wipe off man from off the earth; as dirt is wiped
off from a place which should be clean, and thrown to the dunghill. Or,
I will blot out man from the earth, as those lines are blotted out of a
book which displease the author, or as the name of a citizen is blotted
out of the rolls of the freemen when he is disfranchised. Both man and
beast the creeping thing, and the fowls of the air - These were made for
man, and therefore must be destroyed with man. It repenteth me that I
have made them - For the end of their creation also was frustrated: they
were made that man might serve and honour God with them and therefore
were destroyed, because he had served his lusts with them, and made them
subject to vanity.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p10">8. But Noah found grace in the eyes of the Lord - This
vindicates God's justice in his displeasure against the world, and shews
that he had examined the character of every person in it, before he
pronounced it universally corrupt; for there being one good man he
smiled upon him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p11">9. Noah was a just man - Justified before God by faith in
the promised seed; for he was an heir of the righteousness which is by
faith, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 7" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Heb|11|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.7">Heb. xi, 7</scripRef>. He was sanctified, and had right principles and
dispositions implanted in him: and he was righteous in his conversation,
one that made conscience of rendering to all their due, to God his due,
and to men theirs. And he walked with God as Enoch had done before him:
in his generation, even in that corrupt degenerate age. It is easy to be
religious when religion is in fashion; but it is an evidence of strong
faith to swim against the stream, and to appear for God, when no one
else appears for him: so Noah did, and it is upon record to his immortal
honour.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p12">11. The earth also was corrupt before God - That is, in
the matters of God's worship; either they had other gods before him, or
worshipped him by images: or, they were corrupt and wicked in despite of
God. The earth was also filled with violence, and injustice towards men;
there was no order nor regular government, no man was safe in the
possession of that which he had the most clear right to, there was
nothing but murders, rapes and rapines.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p13">12. God looked upon the earth - And was himself an
eye-witness of the corruption that was in it, for all flesh had
corrupted his way - It was not some particular nations that were thus
wicked, but the whole world so; there was none good beside Noah.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p14">13. The end of all flesh is come before me; I will
destroy them - The ruin of this wicked world is decreed; it is come,
that is, it will come surely, and come quickly.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p15">14. I will destroy them with the earth, but make thee an
ark - I will take care to preserve thee alive. This ark was like the
hulk of a ship, fitted not to sail upon the waters, but to float waiting
for their fall. God could have secured Noah, by the ministration of
angels without putting him to any care or pains, but he chose to employ
him in making that which was to be the means of his preservation, both
for the trial of his faith and obedience, and to teach us that none
shall be saved by Christ, but those only that work out their salvation;
we cannot do it without God, and he will not without us: both the
providence of God and the grace of God crown the endeavours of the
obedient and diligent. God gave him particular instructions concerning
this building.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p16">1. It must be made of Gopher-wood; Noah,
doubtless, knew what sort of wood that was, though now we do not.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p17">2. He must make it three stories high
within: and,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p18">3. He must divide it into cabins with
partitions, places fitted for the several sorts of creatures, so as to
lose no room.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p19">4. Exact dimensions are given him, that he
might make it proportionable, and might have room enough in it to answer
the intention, and no more.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p20">5. He must pitch it within and without:
without, to shed off the rain, and to prevent the water from soaking in;
within, to take away the ill smell of the beasts when kept close.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p21">6. He must make a little window towards the
top to let in light.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p22">7. He must make a door in the side of it by
which to go in and out.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p23">17. And behold, I, even I, do bring a flood of waters
upon the earth - I that am infinite in power, and therefore can do it;
infinite in justice, and therefore will do it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.vii.ii-p24">18. But with thee will I establish my covenant - (1.) The
covenant of Providence, that the course of nature shall be continued to
the end of time, not withstanding the interruption which the flood would
give to it: this promise was immediately made to Noah and his sons,
chap. ix, 8, &amp;c. they were as trustees for all this part of the
creation, and a great honour was thereby put upon him and his. God would
be to him a God, and that out of his seed God would take to himself a
people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="32.79%" prev="ii.ii.vii.ii" next="ii.ii.viii.i" id="ii.ii.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. VII" id="ii.ii.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 7" progress="32.79%" prev="ii.ii.viii" next="ii.ii.viii.ii" id="ii.ii.viii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.viii.i-p1">We have in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.viii.i-p2">I. God's gracious call to Noah to come into
the ark, ver. 1. and to bring the creatures that were to be preserved
alive, with him, ver. 2, 3. in consideration of the deluge at hand, ver.
4.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.viii.i-p3">II. Noah's obedience, ver. 5. he came with
his family into the ark, ver. 6, 7. and brought the creatures with him,
ver. 8, 9. An account of which is repeated, ver. 13, 14, 15, 16. to
which is added God's tender care to shut him in.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.viii.i-p4">III. The coming of the threatened deluge,
ver. 10. the causes of it, ver. 11, 12. the prevalency of it, ver. 17,
18, 19, 20.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.viii.i-p5">IV. The dreadful desolations that were made
by it, in the death of every living creature upon earth, except what
were in the ark, ver. 21, 22,23.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.viii.i-p6">V. The continuance of it in full sea,
before it began to ebb, 150 days, ver. 24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 7" progress="32.81%" prev="ii.ii.viii.i" next="ii.ii.ix" id="ii.ii.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p1">1. Here is a gracious invitation of Noah and his family
into a place of safety, now the flood of waters was coming. For thee
have I seen righteous before me in this generation - Those are righteous
indeed that are righteous before God; that have not only the form of
godliness by which they appear righteous before men, who may easily be
imposed upon; but the power of it, by which they approve themselves to
God, who searcheth the heart.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p2">2. Here are necessary orders given concerning the brute
creatures that they were to be preserved alive with Noah in the ark. He
must carefully preserve every species, that no tribe, no, not the least
considerable, might entirely perish out of the creation. Observe in
this: (1.) God's care for man. Doth God take care for oxen? <scripRef passage="1 Cor. ix. 9" id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|1Cor|9|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.9.9">1 Cor. ix, 9</scripRef>, or was it not rather for man's sake that this care was
taken? (2.) Even the unclean beasts were preserved alive in the ark,
that were least valuable. For God's tender mercies are over all his
works, and not only over those that are of most use. (3.) Yet more of
the clean were preserved than of the unclean.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p3">1. Because the clean were most for the
service of man; and therefore in favour to him, more of them were
preserved and are still propagated. Thanks be to God there are not herds
of lions as there are of oxen, nor flocks of tigers as there are of
sheep.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p4">2. Because the clean were for sacrifice to
God; and therefore, in honour to him, more of them were preserved, three
couple for breed, and the odd seventh for sacrifice, chap. viii, 20.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p5">4. Yet seven days and I will cause it to rain - It shall
be seven days yet before I do it, After the 120 years were expired, God
grants them a reprieve of seven days longer, both to shew how slow he is
to anger, and to give them some farther space for repentance. But all in
vain; these seven days were trifled away after all the rest, they
continued secure until the day that the flood came. While Noah told them
of the judgment at a distance, they were tempted to put off their
repentance: but now he is ordered to tell them that it is at the door;
that they have but one week more to turn them in, to see if that will
now at last awaken them to consider the things that belong to their
peace. But it is common for those that have been careless for their
souls during the years of their health, when they have looked upon death
at a distance, to be as careless during the days, the seven days of
their sickness, when they see it approaching, their hearts being
hardened by the deceitfulness of sin.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p6">7. And Noah went in with his sons, and his wife, and his
sons wives - And the brute creatures readily went in with him. The same
hand that at first brought them to Adam to be named, now brought them to
Noah to be preserved.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p7">11. The six hundredth year of Noah's life, was 1656 years
from the creation. In the second month, the seventeenth day of the month
- Which is reckoned to be about the beginning of November; so that Noah
had had a harvest just before, from which to victual his ark. The same
day the fountains of the great deep were broken up - There needed no new
creation of waters; God has laid up the deep in store-houses, <scripRef passage="Psalm xxxiii. 7" id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Ps|33|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.33.7">Psalm xxxiii, 7</scripRef>, and now he broke up those stores. God had, in the creation,
set bars and doors to the waters of the sea, that they might not return
to cover the earth, Psalm civ; <scripRef passage="Job xxxviii. 9-11" id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Job|38|9|38|11" osisRef="Bible:Job.38.9-Job.38.11">Job xxxviii,
9-11</scripRef>, and now he only removed these ancient mounds and fences,
and the waters of the sea returned to cover the earth, as they had done
at first, chap. i, 9. And the windows of heaven were opened - And the
waters which were above the firmament were poured out upon the world;
those treasures which God has reserved against the time of trouble, the
day of battle and war, <scripRef passage="Job xxxviii. 22, 23" id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p7.3" parsed="|Job|38|22|38|23" osisRef="Bible:Job.38.22-Job.38.23">Job xxxviii, 22, 23</scripRef>. The rain, which ordinarily descends in drops, then came
down in streams. We read, <scripRef passage="Job xxvi. 8" id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p7.4" parsed="|Job|26|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.26.8">Job xxvi, 8</scripRef>. That God binds up the waters in his thick clouds, and the
cloud is not rent under them; but now the bond was loosed, the cloud was
rent, and such rains descended as were never known before or since.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p8">12. It rained without intermission or abatement, forty
days and forty nights - And that upon the whole earth at once.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p9">14. And every beast after his kind - According to the
phrase used in the history of the creation, chap. i, 21, 24, 25, to
intimate, that just as many species as were created at first were saved
now, and no more.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p10">20. The mountains were covered - Therefore there were
mountains before the flood.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p11">21. All flesh died, all in whose nostrils was the breath
of life, of all that was on the dry land, every living substance - And
why so? Man only had done wickedly, and justly is God's hand against
him, but these sheep what have they done? I answer,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p12">1. We are sure God did them no wrong. He is
the sovereign Lord of all life, for he is the sole fountain and author
of it. He that made them as he pleased, might unmake them when he
pleased, and who shall say unto him, What dost thou?</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.viii.ii-p13">2. God did admirably serve the purposes of
his own glory by their destruction, as well as by their creation. Herein
his holiness and justice were greatly magnified: by this it appears that
he hates sin, and is highly displeased with sinners, when even the
inferior creatures, because they are the servants of man, and part of
his possession, and because they have been abused to be the servants of
sin, are destroyed with him. It was likewise an instance of God's
wisdom. As the creatures were made for man when he was made, so they
were multiplied for him when he was multiplied; and therefore, now
mankind was reduced to so small a number, it was fit that the beasts
should proportionable be reduced, otherwise they would have had the
dominion, and would have replenished the earth, and the remnant of
mankind that was left would have been overpowered by them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="32.91%" prev="ii.ii.viii.ii" next="ii.ii.ix.i" id="ii.ii.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. VIII" id="ii.ii.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 8" progress="32.91%" prev="ii.ii.ix" next="ii.ii.ix.ii" id="ii.ii.ix.i">

<p id="ii.ii.ix.i-p1">We have here,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.ix.i-p2">I. The earth made anew, by the recess of
waters, and the appearing of the dry land a second time. (1.) The
increase of the waters is stayed, ver. 1, 2. (2.) They begin sensibly to
abate, ver. 3. (3.) After fifteen days ebbing the ark rests, ver. 4.
(4.) After sixty days ebbing the tops of the mountains appear, ver.5.
(5.) After forty days ebbing, and twenty days before the mountains
appeared, Noah begins to send out his spies, a raven and a dove to gain
intelligence, ver. 6-12. (6.) Two months after the appearing of the tops
of the mountains the waters were gone, and the face of the earth was
dry, ver. 13. tho' not dried so as to be fit for man 'till almost two
months after, ver. 14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.ix.i-p3">II. Man placed anew upon the earth. In
which,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.ix.i-p4">1. Noah's discharge and departure out of
the ark, ver. 15-19.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.ix.i-p5">2. His sacrifice of praise which he offered
to God upon his enlargement, ver. 20.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.ix.i-p6">III. God's acceptance of his sacrifice; and
the promise he made thereupon not to drown the world again, ver. 21, 22.
And thus at length mercy rejoiceth against judgment.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 8" progress="32.93%" prev="ii.ii.ix.i" next="ii.ii.x" id="ii.ii.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p1">1. And God remembered Noah and every living thing - This
is an expression after the manner of men, for not any of his creatures,
much less any of his people are forgotten of God. But the whole race of
mankind, except Noah and his family, was now extinguished, and gone into
the land of forgetfulness, so that God's remembering Noah was the return
of his mercy to mankind, of whom he would not make a full end. Noah
himself, tho' one that had found grace in the eyes of the Lord, yet
seemed to be forgotten in the ark; but at length God returned in mercy
to him, and that is expressed by his remembering him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p2">3. The waters returned from off the earth continually -
Hebrew. they were going and returning; a gradual departure. The heat of
the sun exhaled much, and perhaps the subterraneous caverns soaked in
more.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p3">4. And the ark rested - upon the mountains of Ararat -
Or, Armenia, whether it was directed, not by Noah's prudence, but the
wise providence of God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p4">5. The tops of the mountains were seen - Like little
islands appearing above water. They felt ground above forty days before
they saw it, according to Dr. Lightfoots's computation, whence he infers
that if the waters decreased proportionably, the ark drew eleven cubits
in water.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p5">7. Noah sent forth a raven through the window of the ark,
which went forth, as the Hebrew phrase is, going forth and returning,
that is, flying about, but returning to the ark for rest; probably not
in it, but upon it. This gave Noah little satisfaction: therefore,</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p6">8. He sent forth a dove - Which returned the first time
with no good news, but probably wet and dirty; but the second time she
brought an olive leaf in her bill, which appeared to be fresh plucked
off; a plain indication that now the trees began to appear above water.
Note here, that Noah set forth the dove the second time, seven days
after the first time, and the third time was after seven days too: and
probably the first sending of her out was seven days after the sending
forth of the raven. The olive branch is an emblem of peace.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p7">13. Noah removed the covering of the ark - Not the whole
covering, but so much as would suffice to give him a prospect of the
earth about it: and behold the face of the ground was dry.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p8">14. The earth was dried - So as to be a fit habitation
for Noah.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p9">20. And Noah builded an altar - Hitherto he had done
nothing without particular instructions and commands from God but altars
and sacrifices being already of Divine institution, he did not stay for
a particular command thus to express his thankfulness. And he offered on
the altar, of every clean beast and of every clean fowl - One, the odd
seventh that we read of, ver. 2, 3.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p10">21. And God smelled a sweet savour - Or a savour of rest
from it, as it is in the Hebrew. He was well pleased with Noah's pious
zeal, and these hopeful beginnings of the new world, as men are with
fragrant and agreeable smells. I will not again curse the ground,
Hebrew. I will not add to curse the ground any more - God had cursed the
ground upon the first entrance of sin, chap. iii, 17, when he drowned it
he added to that curse: but now he determines not to add to it any more.
Neither will I again smite any more every living thing - That is, it was
determined that whatever ruin God might bring upon particular persons,
families or countries, he would never again destroy the whole world,
'till the day when time shall be no more. But the reason of this resolve
is surprising; for it seems the same with the reason given for the
destruction of the world, chap. vi, 5. Because the imagination of man's
heart is evil from his youth. But there is this difference: there it is
said, the imagination of man's heart is evil continually, that is, his
actual transgressions continually cry against him; here it is said, that
it is evil from his youth or childhood; he brought it into the world
with him, he was shapen and conceived in it. Now one would think it
should follow, therefore that guilty race shall be wholly extinguished:
No; therefore I will no more take this severe method; for he is rather
to be pitied: and it is but what might be expected from such a
degenerate race. So that if he be dealt with according to his deserts,
one flood must succeed another 'till all be destroyed. God also
promises, that the course of nature should never be discontinued. While
the earth remaineth, and man upon it, there shall be summer and winter,
not all winter, as had been this last year; day and night, not all
night, as probably it was while the rain was descending. Here it is
plainly intimated that this earth is not to remain always; it and all
the works therein must shortly be burnt up. But as long as it doth
remain, God's providence will carefully preserve the regular succession
of times and seasons. To this we owe it, that the world stands, and the
wheel of nature keeps its tack. See here how changeable the times are,
and yet how unchangeable!</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p11">1. The course of nature always changing. As
it is with the times, so it is with the events of time, they are subject
to vicissitudes, day and night, summer and winter counterchanged. In
heaven and hell it is not so; but on earth God hath set the one over
against the other.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p12">2. Yet never changed; it is constant in
this inconstancy; these seasons have never ceased, nor shall cease while
the sun continues such a steady measurer of time, and the moon such a
faithful witness in heaven. This is God's covenant of the day and of the
night, the stability of which is mentioned for the confirming our faith
in the covenant of grace, which is no less inviolable, <scripRef passage="Jer. xxxiii. 20" id="ii.ii.ix.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Jer|33|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.33.20">Jer. xxxiii, 20</scripRef>. We see God's promises to the creatures made good, and
thence may infer that his promises to believers shall be so.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="33.03%" prev="ii.ii.ix.ii" next="ii.ii.x.i" id="ii.ii.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. IX" id="ii.ii.x-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 9" progress="33.03%" prev="ii.ii.x" next="ii.ii.x.ii" id="ii.ii.x.i">

<p id="ii.ii.x.i-p1">In this chapter is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.x.i-p2">I. The covenant of providence settled with
Noah and his sons, ver. 1-11. In this covenant, (1.) God promiseth them
to take care of their lives; so that,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.x.i-p3">1. They should replenish the earth, ver.
1-7.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.x.i-p4">2. They should be safe from the insults of
the brute creatures, which should stand in awe of them, ver. 2.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.x.i-p5">3. They should be allowed to eat flesh for
the support of their lives, only they must not eat blood, ver. 3, 4.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.x.i-p6">4. The world should never be drowned again,
ver. 8-11. (2.) God requires of them to take care of one another's
lives, and of their own, ver. 5, 6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.x.i-p7">II. The seal of that covenant, viz. the
rainbow, ver. 12-17.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.x.i-p8">III. A particular passage concerning Noah
and his sons, which occasioned some prophecies that related to
after-times. (1.) Noah's sin and shame, ver. 20-21. (2.) Ham's impudence
and impiety, ver. 22. (3.) The pious modesty of Shem and Japheth, ver.
23. (4.) The curse of Canaan and the blessing of Shem and Japheth, ver.
24-27.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.x.i-p9">IV. The age and death of Noah, ver. 28,
29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 9" progress="33.05%" prev="ii.ii.x.i" next="ii.ii.xi" id="ii.ii.x.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p1">1. And God blessed Noah and his sons - He assured them of
his goodwill to them, and his gracious intentions concerning them. The
first blessing is here renewed, Be fruitful, and multiply, and replenish
the earth, and repeated, ver. 7; for the race of mankind was as it were
to begin again. By virtue of this blessing mankind was to be both
multiplied and perpetuated upon earth; so that in a little time all the
habitable parts of the earth should be more or less inhabited; and tho'
one generation should pass away, yet another generation should come, so
that the stream of the human race should be supplied with a constant
succession, and run parallel with the current of time, 'till both be
swallowed up in the ocean of eternity.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p2">2. He grants them power over the inferior creatures. He
grants, 1. A title to them; into your hands they are delivered - For
your use and benefit. 2. A dominion over them, without which the title
would avail little; The fear of you and the dread of you shall be upon
every beast - This revives a former grant, chap. i, 28, only with this
difference, that man in innocency ruled by love, fallen man rules by
fear. And thus far we have still the benefit of it,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p3">1. That those creatures which are any way
useful to us are reclaimed, and we use them either for service or food,
or both, as they are capable.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p4">2. Those creatures that are any way hurtful
to us are restrained; so that tho' now and then man may be hurt by some
of them, yet they do not combine together to rise up in rebellion
against man.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p5">3. Every moving thing that liveth shall be meat for you -
Hitherto man had been confined to feed only upon the products of the
earth, fruits, herbs and roots, and all sorts of corn and milk; so was
the first grant, chap. i, 29. But the flood having perhaps washed away
much of the virtue of the earth, and so rendered its fruits less
pleasing, and less nourishing, God now enlarged the grant, and allowed
man to eat flesh, which perhaps man himself never thought of 'till now.
The precepts and provisos of this charter are no less kind and gracious,
and instances of God's goodwill to man. The Jewish doctors speak so
often of the seven precepts of Noah, or of the sons of Noah, which they
say were to be observed by all nations, that it may not be amiss to set
them down. The first against the worship of idols. The second against
blasphemy, and requiring to bless the name of God. The third against
murder. The fourth against incest and all uncleanness. The fifth against
theft and rapine. The sixth requiring the administration of justice. The
seventh against eating flesh with the life. These the Jews required the
observation of, from the proselytes of the gate. But the precepts here
given, all concern the life of man. Man must not prejudice his own life
by eating that food which is unwholsome, and prejudicial to his
health.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p6">4. But flesh with the life thereof, which is the blood
thereof, shall ye not eat - Blood made atonement for the soul, <scripRef passage="Lev. xvii. 11" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Lev|17|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.17.11">Lev. xvii, 11</scripRef>. The life of the sacrifice was accepted for the life of the
sinner. Blood must not be looked upon as a common thing, but must be
poured out before the Lord, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xxiii. 16" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p6.2" parsed="|2Sam|23|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.23.16">2 Sam. xxiii, 16</scripRef>. Mark Henry indeed has a strange conceit, That this is only
a prohibition to eat flesh. This does such apparent violence to the
text, that to mention it, is sufficient.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p7">5. And surely your blood of your lives will I require -
Our own lives are not so our own, that we may quit them at our own
pleasure; but they are God's, and we must resign them at his pleasure.
If we any way hasten our own deaths, we are accountable to God for it.
Yea, At the hand of every beast will I require it - To shew how tender
God was of the life of man, he will have the beast put to death that
kills a man. This was confirmed by the law of Moses, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxi. 28" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Exod|21|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.21.28">Exod. xxi, 28</scripRef>, and it would not be unsafe to observe it still. And at the
hand of every man's brother will I require the life of a man - I will
avenge the blood of the murdered upon the murderer. When God requires
the life of a man at the hand of him that took it away unjustly, he
cannot render that, and therefore must render his own in lieu of it,
which is the only way left of making restitution.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p8">6. Whoso sheddeth man's blood - Whether upon a sudden
provocation, or premeditated, (for rash anger is heart-murder as well as
malice prepense, <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 21, 22" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|5|21|5|22" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.21-Matt.5.22">Matt. v, 21,
22</scripRef>), by man shall his blood be shed - That is, by the
magistrate, or whoever is appointed to be the avenger of blood. Before
the flood, as it should seem by the story of Cain, God took the
punishment of murder into his own hands; but now he committed this
judgment to men, to masters of families at first, and afterwards to the
heads of countries. For in the image of God made he man - Man is a
creature dear to his Creator, and therefore ought to be so to us; God
put honour upon him, let us not then put contempt upon him. Such remains
of God's image are still even upon fallen man, that he who unjustly
kills a man, defaceth the image of God, and doth dishonour to him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p9">9. We have here the general establishment of God's
covenant with this new world, and the extent of that covenant.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p10">11. There shall not any more be a flood - God had drowned
the world once, and still it is as provoking as ever; yet he will never
drown it any more, for he deals not with us according to our sins. This
promise of God keeps the sea and clouds in their decreed place, and sets
them gates and bars, Hitherto they shall come, <scripRef passage="Job xxxviii. 10, 11" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Job|38|10|38|11" osisRef="Bible:Job.38.10-Job.38.11">Job xxxviii, 10, 11</scripRef>. If the sea should flow but for a few days, as it doth twice
every day for a few hours, what desolations would it make? So would the
clouds, if such showers as we have sometimes seen, were continued long.
But God by flowing seas, and sweeping rains, shews what he could do in
wrath; and yet by preserving the earth from being deluged between both,
shews what he can do in mercy, and will do in truth.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p11">13. I set my bow in the clouds - The rainbow, 'tis likely
was seen in the clouds before, but was never a seal of the covenant
'till now. Now, concerning this seal of the covenant, observe, (1.) This
seal is affixed with repeated assurances of the truth of that promise,
which it was designed to be the ratification of; I do set my bow in the
cloud, ver. 13. It shall be seen in the cloud, ver. 14. and it shall be
a token of the covenant, ver. 12, 13. And I will remember my covenant,
that the waters shall no more become a flood, ver. 15. Nay, as if the
eternal Mind needed a memorandum, I will look upon it that I may
remember the everlasting covenant, ver. 16. (2.) The rainbow appears
when the clouds are most disposed to wet; when we have most reason to
fear the rain prevailing, God shews this seal of the promise that it
shall not prevail. (3.) The rainbow appears when one part of the sky is
clear, which imitates mercy remembered in the midst of wrath, and the
clouds are hemmed as it were with the rainbow, that it may not
overspread the heavens, for the bow is coloured rain, or the edges of a
cloud gilded. As God looks upon the bow that he may remember the
covenant, so should we, that we also may be ever mindful of the covenant
with faith and thankfulness.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p12">20. And Noah began to be an husbandman - Hebrew. a man of
the earth, a man dealing in the earth, that kept ground in his hand and
occupied it. Sometime after his departure out of the ark he returned to
his old employment, from which he had been diverted by the building of
the ark first, and probably after by the building an house for himself
and family. And he planted a vineyard - And when he had gathered his
vintage, probably he appointed a day of mirth and feasting in his
family, and had his sons and their children with him, to rejoice with
him in the increase of his house, as well as in the increase of his
vineyard; and we may suppose he prefaced his feast with a sacrifice to
the honour of God. If that was omitted, 'twas just with God to leave him
to himself, to end with the beasts that did not begin with God: but we
charitably hope he did. And perhaps he appointed this feast with design
in the close of it to bless his sons, as Isaac, chap. xxvii, 3, 4. That
I may eat, and that my soul may bless thee.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p13">21. And he drank of the wine and was drunk - 'Tis highly
probable, he did not know the effect of it before. And he was uncovered
in his tent - Made naked to his shame.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p14">22. And Ham saw the nakedness of his father, and told his
two brethren -- to have seen it accidentally and involuntarily would not
have been a crime. But he pleased himself with the sight. And he told
his two brethren without - In the street, as the word is, in a scornful
deriding manner.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p15">23. And Shem and Japheth took a garment, and went
backward, and covered the nakedness of their father - They not only
would not see it themselves, but provided that no one else might see it;
herein setting an example of charity, with reference to other men's sin
and shame.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p16">25. A servant of servants - That is, the meanest and most
despicable servant shall he be, even to his brethren. Those who by birth
were his equals, should by conquest be his lords. This certainly points
at the victories obtained by Israel over the Canaanites, by which they
were all either put to the sword, or put under tribute. <scripRef passage="Josh. ix. 23" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Josh|9|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.9.23">Josh. ix, 23</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="Jude i. 28, 30" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p16.2" parsed="|Jude|1|28|0|0;|Jude|1|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.1.28 Bible:Jude.1.30">Jude i, 28, 30</scripRef>,</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p17">33, 35, which happened not 'till about eight hundred
years after this. God often visits the iniquity of the fathers upon the
children, especially when the children inherit the fathers wicked
dispositions, and imitate the father's wicked practices.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p18">26. The God of Shem - All blessings are included in this.
This was the blessing conferred on Abraham and his seed, the God of
heaven was not ashamed to be called their God, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 16" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Heb|11|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.16">Heb. xi, 16</scripRef>. Shem is sufficiently recompensed for his respect to his
father by this, that the Lord himself puts this honour upon him to be
his God; which is a sufficient recompense for all our services and all
our sufferings for his name.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.x.ii-p19">27. God shall enlarge Japheth, and he shall dwell in the
tents of Shem - His seed shall be so numerous and so victorious, that
they shall be masters of the tents of Shem, which was fulfilled when the
people of the Jews, the most eminent of Shem's race, were tributaries to
the Grecians first, and after to the Romans, both of Japhet's seed. This
also speaks the conversion of the Gentiles, and the bringing of them
into the church; and then we should read it, God shall persuade Japheth;
(for so the word signifies) and being so persuaded, he shall dwell in
the tents of Shem - That is, Jews and Gentiles shall be united together
in the gospel-fold: after many of the Gentiles shall have been
proselyted to the Jewish religion, both shall be one in Christ, <scripRef passage="Eph. ii. 14, 15" id="ii.ii.x.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Eph|2|14|2|15" osisRef="Bible:Eph.2.14-Eph.2.15">Eph. ii, 14, 15</scripRef>. When Japheth joins with Shem, Canaan falls before them
both: when strangers become friends, enemies become servants.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="33.24%" prev="ii.ii.x.ii" next="ii.ii.xi.i" id="ii.ii.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. X" id="ii.ii.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 10" progress="33.24%" prev="ii.ii.xi" next="ii.ii.xi.ii" id="ii.ii.xi.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xi.i-p1">This chapter contains, the only certain account extant of
the original of nations; and yet, perhaps, there is no nation, but that
of the Jews, that can be confident from which of these seventy fountains
(for many there are here) it derived its streams. Through the want of
early records, the mixtures of people, the revolutions of nations, and
distance of time, the knowledge of the lineal descent of the present
inhabitants of the earth is lost: nor were any genealogies preserved but
those of the Jews, for the sake of the Messiah. Only, in this chapter,
we have a brief account,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xi.i-p2">I. Of the posterity of Japheth, ver.
2-5.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xi.i-p3">II. The posterity of Ham, ver. 6-20. and,
in that particular notice taken of Nimrod, ver. 8-9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xi.i-p4">III. The posterity of Shem, ver. 23-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 10" progress="33.25%" prev="ii.ii.xi.i" next="ii.ii.xii" id="ii.ii.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p1">2. Moses begins with Japhet's family, either because he
was the eldest, or because that lay remotest from Israel, and had least
concern with them, at that time when Moses wrote; and therefore he
mentions that race very briefly; hastening to give account of the
posterity of Ham, who were Israel's enemies, and of Shem, who were
Israel's ancestors: for it is the church that the scripture designed to
be the history of, and of the nations of the world only as they were
some way or other interested in the affairs of Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p2">5. The posterity of Japheth were allotted to the isles of
the Gentiles, which were solemnly, by lot, after a survey, divided among
them, and probably this island of ours among the rest. All places beyond
the sea, from Judea, are called isles, <scripRef passage="Jer. xxv. 22" id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Jer|25|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.25.22">Jer. xxv, 22</scripRef>, and this directs us to understand that promise, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xlii. 4" id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Isa|42|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.42.4">Isaiah xlii,
4</scripRef>, the isles shall wait for his law, of the conversion of the
Gentiles to the faith of Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p3">8. Began to be mighty on the earth - That is, whereas
those that went before him were content to stand upon the same level
with their neighbours, Nimrod could not rest in this parity, but he
would top his neighbours, and Lord over them. The same spirit that the
giants before the flood were acted by, chap. vi, 4, now revived in him;
so soon was that tremendous judgment, which the pride and tyranny of
those mighty men brought upon the world, forgotten.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p4">9. Nimrod was a mighty hunter - This he began with, and
for this became famous to a proverb. Some think he did good with his
hunting, served his country by ridding it of wild beasts, and so
insinuated himself into the affections of his neighbours, and got to be
their prince. And perhaps, under pretense of hunting, he gathered men
under his command, to make himself master of the country. Thus he became
a mighty hunter, a violent invader of his neighbour's rights and
properties. And that, before the Lord - Carrying all before him, and
endeavouring to make all his own by force and violence. He thought
himself a mighty prince; but before the Lord, that is, in God's account,
he was but a mighty hunter. Note, Great conquerers are but great
hunters. Alexander and Caesar would not make such a figure in scripture
history as they do in common history. The former is represented in
prophecy but as a he-goat pushing, <scripRef passage="Dan. viii. 5" id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Dan|8|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.8.5">Dan.
viii, 5</scripRef>. Nimrod was a mighty hunter against the Lord, so the
seventy; that is, he set up idolatry, as Jeroboam did, for the
confirming of his usurped dominion; that he might set up a new
government, he set up a new religion upon the ruin of the primitive
constitution of both.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p5">10. The beginning of his kingdom was Babel - Some way or
other, he got into power: and so laid the foundations of a monarchy
which was afterwards a head of gold. It doth not appear that he had any
right to rule by birth; but either his fitness for government
recommended him, or by power and policy he gradually advanced into the
throne. See the antiquity of civil government, and particularly that
form of it which lodges the sovereignty in a single person.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p6">15. The account of the posterity of Canaan, and the land
they possessed is more particular than of any other in this chapter,
because these were the nations that were to be subdued before Israel,
and their land was to become Immanuel's land. And by this account, it
appears that the posterity of Canaan was both numerous and rich, and
very pleasantly seated, and yet Canaan was under a curse. Canaan here
has a better land than either Shem or Japheth and yet they have a better
lot, for they inherit the blessing.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p7">21. Two things especially are observable in this account
of the posterity of Shem. The description of Shem, ver. 21, we have not
only his name, Shem, which signifies a name; but two titles to
distinguish him by.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p8">1. He was the father of all the children of
Eber. Eber was his great grandson, but why should he be called the
father of all his children, rather than of all Arphaxad's or Salah's?
Probably because Abraham and his seed, not only descended from Hebser,
but from him were called Hebrews. Eber himself, we may suppose, was a
man eminent for religion in a time of general apostasy; and the holy
tongue being commonly called from him the Hebrew, it is probable he
retained it in his family in the confusion of Babel, as a special token
of God's favour to him.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xi.ii-p9">2. He was the brother of Japheth the elder;
by which it appears, that though Shem be commonly put first, yet he was
not Noah's first-born, but Japheth was elder. But why should this also
be put as part of Shem's description, that he was the brother of
Japheth, since that had been said before? Probably this is intended to
signify the union of the Gentiles with the Jews in the church. He had
mentioned it as Shem's honour, that he was the father of the Hebrews;
but lest Japheth's seed should therefore be looked upon as shut out from
the church, he here minds us, that he was the brother of Japheth, not in
birth only, but in blessing, for Japheth was to dwell in the tents of
Shem. The reason of the name of Peleg, ver. 25, because, in his days,
(that is, about the time of his birth) was the earth divided among the
children of men that were to inhabit it; either when Noah divided it, by
an orderly distribution of it, as Joshua divided the land of Canaan by
lot, or when, upon their refusal to comply with that division, God, in
justice, divided them by the confusion of tongues.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="33.35%" prev="ii.ii.xi.ii" next="ii.ii.xii.i" id="ii.ii.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XI" id="ii.ii.xii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 11" progress="33.35%" prev="ii.ii.xii" next="ii.ii.xii.ii" id="ii.ii.xii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xii.i-p1">The distinction between the sons of God and the sons of
men, now appeared again, when men began to multiply. According to this
distinction, we have in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xii.i-p2">I. The dispersion of the sons of men at
Babel, ver. 1-9. where we have (1.) Their presumptuous design, to build
a city and a tower, ver. 1- 4. (2.) The righteous judgment of God upon
them in disappointing the design, by confounding their language, and so
scattering them, ver. 5-9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xii.i-p3">II. The pedigree of the sons of God down to
Abraham, ver. 10-26. with a general account of his family, and remove
out of his native country, ver. 27-32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary of Chapter 11" progress="33.36%" prev="ii.ii.xii.i" next="ii.ii.xiii" id="ii.ii.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p1">1. And the whole earth was of one language - Now while
they all understood one another, they would be the more capable of
helping one another, and the less inclinable to separate.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p2">2. And they found a plain in the land of Shinar - A
spacious plain, able to contain them all.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p3">3. Go to, let us make brick, let us build us a city - The
country being a plain, yielded neither stone nor morter, yet that did
not discourage them, but they made brick to serve instead of stone, and
slime, or pitch, instead of morter. Some think they intended hereby to
secure themselves against the waters of another flood, but if they had,
they would have chosen to build upon a mountain rather than upon a
plain. But two things it seems they aimed at in building.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p4">1. To make them a name: they would do
something to be talked of by posterity. But they could not gain this
point; for we do not find in any history the name of so much as one of
these Babel - builders. Philo Judeus saith they engraved every one his
name upon a brick; yet neither did that serve their purpose.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p5">2. They did it to prevent their dispersion;
lest we be scattered abroad upon the face of the earth - It was done
(saith Josephus) in disobedience to that command, chap. ix, 1, replenish
the earth. God orders them to scatter. No, say they, we will live and
die together. In order hereunto they engage themselves and one another
in this vast undertaking. That they might unite in one glorious empire,
they resolve to build this city and tower, to be the metropolis of their
kingdom, and the center of their unity.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p6">5. And the Lord came down to see the city - 'Tis an
expression after the manner of men, he knew it as clearly as men know
that which they come upon the place to view. And the tower which the
children of men builded - Which speaks, (1.) Their weakness and frailty,
it was a foolish thing for the children of men, worms of the earth, to
defy heaven. (2.) Their sinfulness, they were the sons of Adam, so it is
in the Hebrew; nay, of that Adam, that sinful disobedient Adam, whose
children are by nature children of disobedience. (3.) Their distinction
from the children of God, from whom those daring builders had separated
themselves, and built this tower to support and perpetuate the
separation.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p7">6. And the Lord said, Behold the people is one, and they
have all one language - And if they continue one, much of the earth will
be left uninhabited, and these children of men, if thus incorporated,
will swallow up the little remnant of God's children, therefore it is
decreed they must not be one. And now nothing will be restrained from
them - And this is a reason why they must be crossed, in their
design.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p8">7. Go to, let us go down and there confound their
language - This was not spoken to the angels, as if God needed either
their advice or their assistance, but God speaks it to himself, or the
Father to the Son and Holy Ghost. That they may not understand one
another's speech - Nor could they well join hands when their tongues
were divided: so that this was a proper means, both to take them off
from their building, for if they could not understand one another, they
could not help one another; and to dispose them to scatter, for when
they could not understand one another, they could not enjoy one another.
Accordingly three things were done,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p9">1. Their language was confounded. God, who
when he made man taught him to speak, now made those builders to forget
their former language; and to speak a new one, which yet was the same to
those of the same tribe or family, but not to others: those of one
colony could converse together, but not with those of another. We all
suffer hereby to this day: in all the inconveniences we sustain by the
diversity of languages, and all the trouble we are at to learn the
languages we have occasion for, we smart for the rebellion of our
ancestors at Babel; nay, and those unhappy controversies, which are
strifes of words, and arise from our misunderstanding of one another's
languages, for ought I know, are owing to this confusion of tongues. The
project of some to frame an universal character in order to an universal
language, how desirable soever it may seem, yet I think is but a vain
thing for it is to strive against a divine sentence, by which the
languages of the nations will be divided while the world stands. We may
here lament the loss of the universal use of the Hebrew tongue, which
from henceforth was the vulgar language of the Hebrews only, and
continued so till the captivity in Babylon, where, even among them, it
was exchanged for the Syriac. As the confounding of tongues divided the
children of men, and scattered them abroad, so the gift of tongues
bestowed upon the Apostles, <scripRef passage="Acts ii. 4-11" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Acts|2|4|2|11" osisRef="Bible:Acts.2.4-Acts.2.11">Acts ii,
4-11</scripRef>, contributed greatly to the gathering together of the
children of God, which were scattered abroad, and the uniting of them in
Christ, that with one mind and mouth they might glorify God, <scripRef passage="Rom. xv. 6" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p9.2" parsed="|Rom|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.15.6">Rom. xv, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p10">1. The imagination of a late writer, that
God did not confound their tongues, but their religious worship, is
grounded on criticisms concerning the meaning of the Hebrew word, which
are absolutely false. Beside, would God confound their religious
worship? Surely, He is a God of order, and not of confusion.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p11">2. Their building was stopped, they left
off to build the city - This was the effect of the confusion of their
tongue's; for it not only disabled them from helping one another, but
probably struck a damp upon their spirits, since they saw the hand of
the Lord gone out against them.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p12">3. The builders were scattered abroad from
thence upon the face of the whole earth - They departed in companies
after their families and after their tongues, chap. x, 5, 20, 31, to the
several countries and places allotted to them in the division that had
been made, which they knew before, but would not go to take possession
of, 'till now they were forced to it. Observe</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p13">1. The very thing which they feared came
upon them; that dispersion which they thought to evade.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p14">2. That it was God's work; the Lord
scattered them; God's hand is to be acknowledged in all scattering
providences; if the family be scattered, relations scattered, churches
scattered, it is the Lord's doing.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p15">3. That they left behind them a perpetual
memorandum of their reproach in the name given to the place; it was
called Babel, confusion.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p16">4. The children of men were now finally
scattered, and never will come all together again 'till the great day.
when the Son of Man shall sit upon the throne of his glory, and all
nations shall be gathered before him, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxv. 31, 32" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Matt|25|31|25|32" osisRef="Bible:Matt.25.31-Matt.25.32">Matt. xxv, 31, 32</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p17">10. Observe here,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p18">1. That nothing is left upon record
concerning those of this line, but their names and ages; the Holy Ghost
seeming to hasten thro' them to the story of Abraham. How little do we
know of those that are gone before us in this world, even those that
lived in the same places where we live! Or indeed of those who are our
contemporaries, but in distant places.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p19">2. That there was an observable gradual
decrease in the years of their lives. Shem reached to 600 years, which
yet fell short of the age of the patriarchs before the flood; the three
next came short of 500, the three next did not reach to 300, and after
them we read not of any that attained to 200 but Terah; and not many
ages after this, Moses reckoned 70 or 80 to be the utmost men ordinarily
arrive at. When the earth began to be replenished, mens lives began to
shorten so that the decrease is to be imputed to the wise disposal of
providence, rather than to any decay of nature.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p20">3. That Eber, from whom the Hebrews were
denominated, was the longest lived of any that were born after the
flood; which perhaps was the reward of his strict adherence to the ways
of God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p21">27. Here begins the story of Abram. We have here,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p22">1. His country: Ur of the Chaldee's - An
idolatrous country, where even the children of Eber themselves
degenerated.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p23">2. His relations, mentioned for his sake,
and because of their interest in he following story.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p24">1. His father was Terah, of whom it is
said, <scripRef passage="Josh. xxiv. 2" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p24.1" parsed="|Josh|24|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.24.2">Josh. xxiv, 2</scripRef>, that he served other gods on the other side the flood; so
early did idolatry gain footing in the world. Enough it is said, ver.
26, that when Terah was seventy years old he begat Abram, Nabor and
Haran, which seems to tell us that Abram was the eldest son of Terah,
and born in the 70th year; yet by comparing ver. 32, which makes Terah
to die in his 205th year, with <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 4" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p24.2" parsed="|Acts|7|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.4">Acts vii, 4</scripRef>, where it is said that Abram removed from Haran when his
father was dead, and chap. xii, 4, where it is said that he was but 75
years old when he removed from Haran, it appears that he was born in the
130th year of Terah, and probably was his youngest son. We have,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p25">2. Some account of his brethren (1.) Nahor,
out of whole family both Isaac and Jacob had their wives. (2.) Haran,
the father of Lot, of whom it is here said, ver. 28, that he died before
his father Terah. 'Tis likewise said that he died in Ur of the Chaldees,
before that happy remove of the family out of that idolatrous country.
(3.) His wife was Sarai, who, tho' some think was the same with Iscah
the daughter of Haran. Abram himself saith, she was the daughter of his
father, but not the daughter of his mother, chap. xx, 12. She was ten
years younger than Abram.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xii.ii-p26">3. His departure out of Ur of the Chaldees,
with his father Terah, and his nephew Lot, and the rest of his family,
in obedience to the call of God. This chapter leaves them in Haran or
Charran, a place about the mid-way between Ur and Canaan, where they
dwelt 'till Terah's head was laid; probably because the old man was
unable, through the infirmities of age, to proceed in his journey.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="33.53%" prev="ii.ii.xii.ii" next="ii.ii.xiii.i" id="ii.ii.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XII" id="ii.ii.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 12" progress="33.53%" prev="ii.ii.xiii" next="ii.ii.xiii.ii" id="ii.ii.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.i-p1">From henceforward Abram and his seed are almost the only
subject of the sacred history. In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xiii.i-p2">I. God's call of Abram to the land of
Canaan ver. 1, 2, 3.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xiii.i-p3">II. Abram's obedience to this call, ver. 4,
5.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xiii.i-p4">III. His welcome to the land of Canaan,
ver. 6-9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xiii.i-p5">IV. His occasional remove into Egypt, with
an account of what happened to him there. Abram's flight and fault, ver.
10-13. Sarai's danger and deliverance, ver. 14-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 12" progress="33.54%" prev="ii.ii.xiii.i" next="ii.ii.xiv" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p1">1. We have here the call by which Abram was removed out
of the land of his nativity into the land of promise, which was designed
both to try his faith and obedience, and also to set him apart for God.
The circumstances of this call we may be somewhat helped to the
knowledge of, from Stephen's speech, <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 2" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Acts|7|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.2">Acts vii, 2</scripRef>, where we are told, 1. That the God of glory appeared to him
to give him this call, appeared in such displays of his glory as left
Abram no room to doubt. God spake to him after in divers manners: but
this first time, when the correspondence was to be settled, he appeared
to him as the God of glory, and spake to him. 2. That this call was
given him in Mesopotamia, before he dwelt in Charran, and in obedience
to this call, he came out of the land of the Chaldeans, and dwelt in
Charran or Haran about five years, and from thence, when his father was
dead, by a fresh command, he removed him into the land of Canaan. Some
think Haran was in Chaldea, and so was still a part of Abram's country;
or he having staid there five years, began to call it his country, and
to take root there, till God let him know this was not the place he was
intended for. Get thee out of thy country - Now, (1.) By this precept he
was tried whether he loved God better than he loved his native soil, and
dearest friends, and whether he could willingly leave all to go along
with God. His country was become idolatrous, his kindred and his
father's house were a constant temptation to him, and he could not
continue with them without danger of being infected by them; therefore
get thee out, (Hebrew.) vade tibi, get thee gone with all speed, escape
for thy life, look not behind thee. (2.) By this precept he was tried
whether he could trust God farther than he saw him, for he must leave
his own country to go to a land that God would shew him; he doth not
say, 'tis a land that I will give thee nor doth he tell him what land it
was, or what kind of land; but he must follow God with an implicit
faith, and take God's word for it in the general, though he had no
particular securities given him, that he should be no loser by leaving
his country to follow God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p2">2. Here is added an encouraging promise, nay a
complication of promises,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p3">1. I will make of thee a great nation -
When God took him from his own people, he promised to make him the head
of another people. This promise was.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p4">1. A great relief to Abram's burden, for he
had now no child.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p5">2. A great trial to Abram's faith, for his
wife had been long barren, so that if he believe, it must be against
hope, and his faith must build purely upon that power which can out of
stones raise up children unto Abraham.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p6">2. I will bless thee - Either particularly
with the blessing of fruitfulness, as he had blessed Adam and Noah; or
in general, I will bless thee with all manner of blessings, both of the
upper and nether springs: leave thy father's house, and I will give thee
a father's blessing, better than that of thy progenitors.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p7">3. I will make thy name great - By
deserting his country he lost his name there: care not for that, (saith
God) but trust me, and I will make thee a greater name than ever thou
couldst have had there.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p8">4. Thou shalt be a blessing - That is, thy
life shall be a blessing to the places where thou shalt sojourn.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p9">5. I will bless them that bless thee, and
curse him that curseth thee - This made it a kind of league offensive
and defensive between God and Abram. Abram heartily espoused God's
cause, and here God promiseth to interest himself in his.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p10">6. In thee shall all the families of the
earth be blessed - This was the promise that crowned all the rest, for
it points at the Messiah, in whom all the promises are yea and amen.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p11">4. So Abram departed - He was not disobedient to the
heavenly vision. His obedience was speedy and without delay, submissive
and without dispute.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p12">5. They took with them the souls that they had gotten -
That is, the proselytes they had made, and persuaded to worship the true
God, and to go with them to Canaan; the souls which (as one of the
Rabbins expresseth it) they had gathered under the wings of the divine
Majesty.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p13">6. The Canaanite was then in the land - He found the
country possessed by Canaanites, who were likely to be but bad
neighbours; and for ought appears he could not have ground to pitch his
tent on but by their permission.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p14">7. And the Lord appeared to Abram - Probably in a vision,
and spoke to him comfortable words; Unto thy seed will I give this land
- No place or condition can shut us out from God's gracious visits.
Abram is a sojourner, unsettled, among Canaanites, and yet here also he
meets with him that lives, and sees him. Enemies may part us and our
tents, us and our altars, but not us and our God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p15">8. And there he built an altar unto the Lord who appeared
to him, and called on the name of the Lord - Now consider this, (1.) As
done upon a special occasion when God appeared to him, then and there he
built an altar, with an eye to the God that appeared to him: thus he
acknowledged with thankfulness God's kindness to him in making him that
gracious visit and promise: and thus he testified his confidence in, and
dependence upon the word which God had spoken. (2.) As his constant
practice, whithersoever he removed. As soon as Abram was got to Canaan,
though he was but a stranger and sojourner there, yet he set up, and
kept up, the worship of God in his family; and wherever he had a tent,
God had an altar and that an altar sanctified by prayer.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p16">10. And there was a famine in the land - Not only to
punish the iniquity of the Canaanites, but to exercise the faith of
Abram. Now he was tried whether he could trust the God that brought him
to Canaan, to maintain him there, and rejoice in him as the God of his
salvation, when the fig-tree did not blossom. And Abram went down into
Egypt - See how wisely God provides, that there should be plenty in one
place, when there was scarcity in another; that, as members of the great
body, we may not say to one another, I have no need of you.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p17">13. Say thou art my sister - The grace Abram was most
eminent for was faith, and yet he thus fell through unbelief and
distrust of the divine Providence, even after God had appeared to him
twice. Alas, What will become of the willows, when the cedars are thus
shaken</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p18">17. And the Lord plagued Pharaoh and his house -
Probably, those princes especially that had commended Sarai to Pharaoh.
We are not told, particularly, what these plagues were; but, doubtless,
there was something in the plagues themselves, or some explication added
to them, sufficient to convince them that it was for Sarai's sake they
were thus plagued.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p19">18. What is this that thou hast done? - What an ill
thing; how unbecoming a wife and good man! Why didst thou not tell me
that she was thy wife? - Intimating, that if he had known that, he would
not have taken her. It is a fault, too common among good people, to
entertain suspicions of others beyond what there is cause for. We have
often found more of virtue, honour, and conscience in some people, than
we thought there was; and it ought to be a pleasure to us to be thus
disappointed, as Abram was here, who found Pharaoh to be a better man
than he expected.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiii.ii-p20">20. And Pharaoh commanded his men concerning him - That
is, he charged them not to injure him in any thing. And he appointed
them, when Abram was disposed to return home, after the famine, to
conduct him safe out of the country, as his convoy.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="33.67%" prev="ii.ii.xiii.ii" next="ii.ii.xiv.i" id="ii.ii.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XIII" id="ii.ii.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 13" progress="33.67%" prev="ii.ii.xiv" next="ii.ii.xiv.ii" id="ii.ii.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xiv.i-p1">In this chapter we have a farther account of Abram;</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xiv.i-p2">I. In general, of his condition and
behaviour in the land of promise, which was, now, the land of his
pilgrimage. (1.) His removes, ver. 1,3, 4, 18. (2.) His riches, ver. 2.
(3.) His devotion, ver. 4, 18.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xiv.i-p3">II. A particular account of a quarrel that
happened between him and Lot. (1.) The occasion of their strife, ver. 5,
6. (2.) The parties concerned in the strife, with the aggravation of it,
ver. 7. (3.) The stopping of it by the prudence of Abram, ver. 8, 9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xiv.i-p4">III. Lot's departure from Abram to the
plain of Sodom, ver. 10-14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xiv.i-p5">IV. God's appearance to Abram, to confirm
the promise of the land of Canaan to him, ver. 14-17.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 13" progress="33.68%" prev="ii.ii.xiv.i" next="ii.ii.xv" id="ii.ii.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p1">3. He went on to Bethel - Thither he went, not only
because he was willing to go among his old acquaintance; but because
there he had formerly had his altar. and though the altar was gone,
probably he himself having taking it down when he left the place, lest
it should be polluted by the idolatrous Canaanites; yet he came to the
place of the altar, either to revive the remembrance of the sweet
communion he had had with God at that place, or, perhaps, to pay the
vows he had there made to God when he undertook his journey into
Egypt.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p2">6. The land was not able to bear them - The place was too
strait for them, and they had not room for their flocks.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p3">7. And the Canaanite and the Perizzite dwelled in the
land - This made the quarrel,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p4">1. Very dangerous; if Abram and Lot cannot
agree to feed their flocks together, it is well if the common enemy do
not come upon them and plunder them both.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p5">2. Very scandalous: No doubt the eyes of
all the neighbours were upon them, because of the singularity of their
religion, and the extraordinary sanctity they professed; and notice
would soon be taken of this quarrel, and improvement made of it to their
reproach by the Canaanites and Perizzites.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p6">10. The garden of the Lord - That is, paradise.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p7">13. Sinners before the Lord - That is, impudent daring
sinners.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p8">16. I will make thy seed as the dust of the earth - That
is, they shall increase incredibly, and take them altogether; they shall
be such a great multitude as no man can number. They were so in
Solomon's time, <scripRef passage="1 Kings iv. 20" id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p8.1" parsed="|1Kgs|4|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.4.20">1 Kings iv,
20</scripRef>. Judah and Israel were many as the land which is by the sea
in multitude. This God here gives him the promise of.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p9">17. Arise, walk through the land - Enter and take
possession, survey the parcels, and it will appear better than upon a
distant prospect.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xiv.ii-p10">18. Then Abram removed his tent - God bid him walk
through the land, that is, Do not think of fixing in it, but expect to
be always unsettled, and walking through it to a better Canaan; in
compliance with God's will herein, he removed his tent, conforming
himself to the condition of a pilgrim. And he built there an altar - in
token of his thankfulness to God for the kind visit he had made him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="33.72%" prev="ii.ii.xiv.ii" next="ii.ii.xv.i" id="ii.ii.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XIV" id="ii.ii.xv-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 14" progress="33.72%" prev="ii.ii.xv" next="ii.ii.xv.ii" id="ii.ii.xv.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xv.i-p1">We have in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xv.i-p2">I. A war with the king of Sodom and his
allies, ver. 1-12.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xv.i-p3">II. Abram's rescue of Lot from captivity,
ver. 13-16.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xv.i-p4">III. Abram's return from that expedition,
ver. 17. with an account of what passed, (1.) Between him and the king
of Salem, ver. 18-20. (2.) Between him and the king of Sodom, ver.
21-24. In part fulfilled, that God would make his name great.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 14" progress="33.73%" prev="ii.ii.xv.i" next="ii.ii.xvi" id="ii.ii.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p1">1. We have here an account of the first war that ever we
read of in scripture, in which we may observe. [1.] The parties engaged
in it. The invaders were four kings; two of them no less than kings of
Shinar and Elam - That is, Chaldea and Persia; yet probably not the
sovereign princes of those great kingdoms, but rather the heads of some
colonies which came out thence, and settled themselves near Sodom, but
retained the names of the countries from which they had their origin.
The invaded were the kings of five cities that lay near together in the
plain of Jordan, Sodom and Gomorrah, Admah, Zeboiim, and Zoar. [2.] The
occasion of this war was, the revolt of the five kings from under the
government of Chedorlaomer.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p2">4. Twelve years they served him - The Sodomites were the
posterity of Canaan, whom Noah had pronounced a servant to Shem, from
whom Elam descended. Thus soon did that prophecy begin to be fulfilled.
In the thirteenth year, beginning to be weary of their subjection, they
rebelled - Denied their tribute, and attempted to shake off the
yoke.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p3">5. In the fourteenth year - After some pause and
preparation, Chedorlaomer, in conjunction with his allies, set himself
to reduce the revolters. See note at "ver. 1" (For [1.], [2.]) [3.] The
progress of the war. The four kings laid the neighbouring countries
waste, and enriched themselves with the spoil of them, ver. 5, 6, 7.
Upon the alarm of which, the king of Sodom and his allies went out and
were routed.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p4">13. We have here an account of the only military action
we ever find Abram engaged in; and this he was not prompted to by
avarice or ambition, but purely by a principle of charity.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p5">14. He armed his trained servants, born in his house - To
the number of three hundred and eighteen: a great family, but a small
army; about as many as Gideon's that routed the Midianites, <scripRef passage="Jude vii. 7" id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Jude|7|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.7.7">Jude vii, 7</scripRef>. He drew out his trained servants, or his catechized
servants; not only instructed in the art of war, but instructed in the
principles of religion; for Abram commanded his household to keep the
way of the Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p6">16. His brother Lot - That is, his kinsman.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p7">18. The Rabbins say, that Melchizedek was Shem the son of
Noah, who was king and priest to those that descended from him,
according to the patriarchal model. Many Christian writers have thought
that this was an appearance of the Son of God himself, our Lord Jesus,
known to Abram at this time by this name. But as nothing is expressly
revealed concerning it, we can determine nothing. He brought forth bread
and wine - For the refreshment of Abram and his soldiers, and in
congratulation of their victory. This he did as a king. As priest of the
most high God he blessed Abram, which we may suppose a greater
refreshment to Abram than his bread and wine were.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p8">19. Blessed be Abram, of the most high God - Observe the
titles he here gives to God, which are very glorious.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p9">1. The most high God, which speaks his
absolute perfections in himself, and his sovereign dominion over all the
creatures.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p10">2. Possessor of heaven and earth - That is,
rightful owner and sovereign Lord of all the creatures; because he made
them.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p11">20. And blessed be the most high God - Note,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p12">1. In all our prayers we must praise God,
and join hallelujahs with all our hosannas. These are the spiritual
sacrifices we must offer up daily, and upon particular occasions.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p13">2. God as the most high God must have the
glory of all our victories. In them he shews himself higher than our
enemies, and higher than we, for without him we could do nothing. And he
gave him tithes of all - That is, of the spoils, <scripRef passage="Heb. vii. 4" id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Heb|7|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.7.4">Heb. vii, 4</scripRef>. This may be looked upon, (1.) As a gratuity presented to
Melchizedek, by way of return for his respects. (2.) As an offering
dedicated to the most high God, and therefore put into the hands of
Melchizedek his priest. Jesus Christ, our great Melchizedek, is to be
humbly acknowledged by every one of us as our king and priest, and not
only the tithe of all, but all we have, must be given up to him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p14">21. Give me the souls, and take thou the substance - So
the Hebrew reads it. Here he fairly begs the persons, but as freely
bestows the goods on Abram. Gratitude teaches us to recompense to the
utmost of our power those that have undergone fatigues, or been at
expence for our service.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p15">22. I have lift up mine hand to the Lord that I will not
take anything - Here Observe, (1.) The titles he gives to God, the most
high God, the possessor of heaven and earth - The same that Melchizedek
had just now used. It is good to learn of others how to order our speech
concerning God, and to imitate those who speak well in divine things.
(2.) The ceremony used in this oath; I have lift up my hand - In
religious swearing we appeal to God's knowledge of our truth and
sincerity, and imprecate his wrath if we swear falsely; and the lifting
up of the hands is expressive of both. Lest thou shouldst say, I have
made Abram rich - Probably, Abram knew the king of Sodom to be a proud
and scornful man, and one that would be apt to turn such a thing as this
to his reproach afterwards, and when we have to do with such men, we
have need to act with particular caution.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xv.ii-p16">23. From a thread to a shoe-latchet - Not the least thing
that had ever belonged to the king of Sodom.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="33.82%" prev="ii.ii.xv.ii" next="ii.ii.xvi.i" id="ii.ii.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XV" id="ii.ii.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 15" progress="33.82%" prev="ii.ii.xvi" next="ii.ii.xvi.ii" id="ii.ii.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.i-p1">In this chapter we have a solemn treaty between God and
Abram,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xvi.i-p2">I. A general assurance of God's kindness
and goodwill to Abram, ver. 1.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xvi.i-p3">II. A particular declaration of the
purposes of his love concerning him, in two things. (1.) That he would
give him a numerous issue, ver. 2-7. (2.) That he would give him Canaan
for an inheritance, ver. 7-16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 15" progress="33.83%" prev="ii.ii.xvi.i" next="ii.ii.xvii" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p1">1. After these things - (1.) After that act of generous
charity which Abram had done, in rescuing his neighbours, God made him
this gracious visit. (2.) After that victory which he had obtained over
four kings; lest Abram should be too much elevated with that, God comes
to tell him he had better things in store for him. The word of the Lord
came unto Abram - That is, God manifested himself to Abram, in a vision
- Which supposeth Abram awake, and some sensible token of the presence
of the divine glory, saying, Fear not Abram - Abram might fear lest the
four kings he had routed, should rally and fall upon him. No, saith God,
fear not: fear not their revenge, nor thy neighbour's envy; I will take
care of thee. I am thy shield - Or, emphatically, I am a shield to thee,
present with thee, actually defending thee. The consideration of this,
that God himself is, a shield to his people, to secure them from all
destructive evils, a shield ready to them, and a shield round about
them, should silence all perplexing fears. And thy exceeding great
reward - Not only thy rewarder, but thy reward. God himself is the
felicity of holy souls; He is the portion of their inheritance, and
their cup.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p2">3. Behold to me thou hast given no seed - Not only no
son, but no seed. If he had had a daughter, from her the promised
Messias might have come, who was to be the Seed of the Woman; but he had
neither son nor daughter.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p3">5. And he brought him forth - It seems, early in the
morning, and said, look now toward heaven, and tell the stars: so shall
thy seed be -</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p4">1. So innumerable, for so the stars seem to
a common eye. Abram feared he should have no child at all, but God tells
him his descendents should be so many as not to be numbered.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p5">2. So illustrious, as the stars of heaven
for splendour; for to them pertained the glory, <scripRef passage="Rom. ix. 4" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Rom|9|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.9.4">Rom. ix, 4</scripRef>. Abram's seed according to the flesh were like the dust of
the earth, Chap. xiii, 16, but his spiritual seed are like the stars of
heaven.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p6">6. And he believed in the Lord - That is, believed the
truth of that promise which God had now made him, resting upon the
power, and faithfulness of him that made it: see how the apostle
magnifies this faith of Abram, and makes it a standing example, <scripRef passage="Rom. iv. 19-21" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Rom|4|19|4|21" osisRef="Bible:Rom.4.19-Rom.4.21">Rom. iv, 19-21</scripRef>. He was not weak in faith; he staggered not at the promise:
he was strong in faith; he was fully persuaded. The Lord work such a
faith in every one of us. And he counted it to him for righteousness -
That is, upon the score of this he was accepted of God, and, by faith he
obtained witness that he was righteous, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 4" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Heb|11|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.4">Heb. xi, 4</scripRef>. This is urged in the New Testament to prove, that we are
justified by faith without the works of the law, <scripRef passage="Rom. iv. 3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p6.3" parsed="|Rom|4|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.4.3">Rom. iv, 3</scripRef>,<scripRef passage="Gal. iii. 6" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p6.4" parsed="|Gal|3|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.3.6">Gal. iii, 6</scripRef>, for Abram was so justified, while he was yet uncircumcised.
If Abram, that was so rich in good works, was not justified by them, but
by his faith, much less can we. This faith, which was imputed to Abram
for righteousness, had newly struggled with unbelief, ver. 2, and coming
off, conqueror, it was thus crowned, thus honoured.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p7">7. I am the Lord that brought thee out of Ur of the
Chaldees - Out of the fire of the Chaldees, so some: that is, from their
idolatries; for the Chaldeans worshipped the fire. Or, from their
persecutions. The Jewish writers have a tradition, that Abram was cast
into a fiery furnace for refusing to worship idols, and was miraculously
delivered. It is rather a place of that name. Thence God brought him by
an effectual call, brought him by a gracious violence; snatched him as a
brand out of the burning. Observe how God speaks of it as that which he
gloried in. I am the Lord that brought thee out - He glories in it as an
act both of power and grace. To give thee this land to inherit it - Not
only to possess it, but to possess it as an inheritance, which is the
surest title. The providence of God hath secret, but gracious designs in
all its various dispensations: we cannot conceive the projects of
providence, 'till the event shews what it was driving at.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p8">8. Whereby shall I know that I shall inherit it? - This
did not proceed from distrust of God's power or promise, but he desired
this,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p9">1. For the strengthening of his own faith.
He believed, ver. 6, but here he prays, Lord help me against my
unbelief, Now, he believed, but he desired a sign, to be treasured up
against an hour of temptation.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p10">2. For the ratifying of the promise to his
posterity, that they also might believe it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p11">9. Take me an heifer - Perhaps Abram expected some sign
from heaven, but God gives him a sign upon a sacrifice. Those that would
receive the assurances of God's favour, must attend instituted
ordinances, and expect to meet with God in them. Observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p12">1. God appointed that each of the beasts
used for his service should be three years old, because then they were
at their full growth and strength. God must be served with the best we
have.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p13">2. We do not read that God gave Abram
particular directions how to manage these, knowing that he was well
versed in the custom of sacrifices.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p14">3. Abram took as God appointed him, though
as yet he knew not how these things should become a sign to him. He
divided the beasts in the midst, according to the ceremony used in
continuing covenants, <scripRef passage="Jer. xxxiv. 18, 19" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Jer|34|18|34|19" osisRef="Bible:Jer.34.18-Jer.34.19">Jer. xxxiv,
18, 19</scripRef>, where it is said, they cut the calf in twain, and passed
between the parts.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p15">4. Abram, having prepared according to
God's appointment, set himself to expect what sign God would give him by
these.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p16">12. And when the sun was going down - About the time of
the evening oblation. Early in the morning, while the stars were yet to
be seen, God had given him orders concerning the sacrifices, ver. 5, and
we may suppose it was at least his morning's work to prepare them, and
set them in order; which when he had done, he abode by them praying and
waiting 'till towards evening. A deep sleep fell upon Abram - Not a
common sleep through weariness or carelessness, but a divine extasy,
that being wholly taken off from things sensible, he might be wholly
taken up with the contemplation of things spiritual. The doors of the
body were locked up, that the soul might be private and retired, and
might act the more freely. And lo, a horror of great darkness fell upon
him - This was designed to strike an awe upon the spirit of Abram, and
to possess him with a holy reverence. Holy fear prepares the soul for
holy joy; God humbles first, and then lifts up.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p17">13. Thy seed shall be strangers - So they were in Canaan
first, <scripRef passage="Psalm cv. 11, 12" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Ps|105|11|105|12" osisRef="Bible:Ps.105.11-Ps.105.12">Psalm cv, 11,
12</scripRef>, and afterwards in Egypt: before they were lords of their
own land, they were strangers in a strange land. The inconveniences of
an unsettled state make a happy settlement the more welcome. Thus the
heirs of heaven are first strangers on earth. And them they shall serve
- So they did the Egyptians, <scripRef passage="Exod. i. 13" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p17.2" parsed="|Exod|1|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.1.13">Exod. i,
13</scripRef>. See how that which was the doom of the Canaanites, chap.
ix, 25, proves the distress of Abram's seed: they are made to serve; but
with this difference, the Canaanites serve under a curse, the Hebrews
under a blessing. And they shall afflict them - See <scripRef passage="Exod. i. 11" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p17.3" parsed="|Exod|1|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.1.11">Exod. i, 11</scripRef>. Those that are blessed and beloved of God are often
afflicted by wicked men. This persecution began with mocking, when
Ishmael the son of an Egyptian, persecuted Isaac, chap. xxi, 9, and it
came at last to murder, the basest of murders, that of their new born
children; so that more or less it continued 400 years.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p18">14. That nation whom they shall serve, even the
Egyptians, will I judge - This points at the plagues of Egypt, by which
God not only constrained the Egyptians to release Israel, but punished
them for all the hardships they had put upon them. The punishing of
persecutors is the judging of them; it is a righteous thing with God,
and a particular act of justice, to recompense tribulation to those that
trouble his people. 3. The deliverance of Abram's seed out of Egypt. And
afterwards shall they come out with great substance - Either after they
have been afflicted 400 years, or, after the Egyptians are judged and
plagued.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p19">15. Thou shalt go to thy fathers - At death we go to our
fathers, to all our fathers that are gone before us to the state of the
dead, to our godly fathers that are gone before us to the state of the
blessed. The former helps to take off the terror of death, the latter
puts comfort into it. Thou shalt be buried in a good old age - Perhaps
mention is made of his burial here, where the land of Canaan is promised
him, because a burying-place was the first possession he had in it. Old
age is a blessing, if it be a good old age: theirs may be called a good
old age,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p20">1. That are old and healthful, not loaded
with such distempers as make them weary of life:</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p21">2. That are old and holy, whose hoary head
is found in the way of righteousness, old and useful, old and exemplary
for godliness, that is indeed a good old age.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p22">16. They shall come hither again - Hither to the land of
Canaan, wherein thou now art. The reason why they must not have the land
of promise in possession till the fourth generation, is because the
iniquity of the Amorites was not yet full. The righteous God has
determined, that they shall not be cut off till they are arrived to such
a pitch of wickedness; and therefore till it come to that, the seed of
Abram must be kept out of possession.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p23">17. When the sun was gone down the sign was given - The
smoaking furnace signified the affliction of his seed in Egypt: they
were there in the furnace of affliction, and labouring in the very fire.
They were there in the smoke, their eyes darkened that they could not
see to the end of their troubles. 2. The burning lamp speaks comfort in
this affliction; and this God shewed Abram at the same time with the
smoaking furnace. The lamp notes direction in the smoke; God's word was
their lamp, a light shining in a dark place. Perhaps too this burning
lamp prefigured the pillar of a cloud and fire which led them out of
Egypt. 3. The passing of these between the pieces was the confirming of
the covenant God now made with him. It is probable this furnace and
lamp, which passed between the pieces, burned and consumed them, and so
compleated the sacrifice, and testified God's acceptance of it, as of
Gideon's, <scripRef passage="Jude vi. 21" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p23.1" parsed="|Jude|6|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.6.21">Jude vi, 21</scripRef>, Manoah's, <scripRef passage="Jude xiii. 19, 20" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p23.2" parsed="|Jude|13|19|13|20" osisRef="Bible:Jude.13.19-Jude.13.20">Jude xiii, 19, 20</scripRef>, and Solomon's, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. vii. 1" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p23.3" parsed="|2Chr|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.7.1">2 Chron. vii, 1</scripRef>. So it intimates,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p24">1. That God's covenants with man are made
by sacrifice, <scripRef passage="Psalm l. 5" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p24.1" parsed="|Ps|50|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.50.5">Psalm l, 5</scripRef>, by Christ, the great sacrifice.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p25">2. God's acceptance of our spiritual
sacrifices is a token for good, and an earnest of farther favours.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p26">18. In that same day, the Lord made a covenant with
Abram, saying, Unto thy seed have I given this land - He had said
before, To thy seed will I give this land, but here he saith, I have
given it; that is,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p27">1. I have given the promise, the charter is
sealed and delivered, and cannot be disanulled.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p28">2. The possession is as sure in due time,
as if it were now actually delivered to them. In David's time and
Solomon's their jurisdiction extended to the utmost of these limits, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. ix. 26" id="ii.ii.xvi.ii-p28.1" parsed="|2Chr|9|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.9.26">2 Chron. ix, 26</scripRef>. And it was their own fault that they were not sooner and
longer in possession of all these territories. They forfeited their
right by their sins, and by their own sloth and cowardice kept
themselves out of possession. The present occupants are named, because
their number and strength and long prescription, should be no hindrance
to the accomplishment of this promise in its season; and to magnify
God's love to Abram and his seed, in giving to that one nation the
possession of many nations.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="34.03%" prev="ii.ii.xvi.ii" next="ii.ii.xvii.i" id="ii.ii.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XVI" id="ii.ii.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 16" progress="34.03%" prev="ii.ii.xvii" next="ii.ii.xvii.ii" id="ii.ii.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.i-p1">Hagar probably was one of those maid-servants which the
king of Egypt (among other gifts) bestowed upon Abram, chap. xii. 16.
Concerning her we have four things in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xvii.i-p2">I. Her marriage to Abram her master, ver.
1-3.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xvii.i-p3">II. Her misbehaviour towards Sarai her
mistress, ver. 4-6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xvii.i-p4">III. Her discourse with an angel that met
her in her flight, ver. 7- 14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xvii.i-p5">IV. Her delivery of a son, ver. 15, 16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 16" progress="34.03%" prev="ii.ii.xvii.i" next="ii.ii.xviii" id="ii.ii.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p1">1. We have here the marriage of Abram to Hagar, who was
his secondary wife. Herein, though he may be excused, he cannot be
justified; for from the beginning it was not so: and when it was so, it
seems to have proceeded from an irregular desire to build up their
families, for the speedier peopling of the world. But now we must not do
so? Christ has reduced this matter to the first institution, and makes
the marriage union to be between one man and one woman only.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p2">4. We have here the ill consequences of Abram's marriage
to Hagar: a deal of mischief it made presently. Hagar no sooner
perceives herself with child, but she looks scornfully upon her
mistress; upbraids her perhaps with her barrenness, and insults over
her. Sarai falls upon Abram, and very unjustly charges him with the
injury, suspecting that he countenanced Hagar's insolence: and as one
not willing to hear what Abram had to say she rashly appeals to God. The
Lord judge between me and thee, as if Abram had refused to right her.
When passion is upon the throne, reason is out of doors, and is neither
heard nor spoken. Those are not always in the right that are most
forward in appealing to God. Rash and bold imprecations are commonly
evidences of guilt and a bad cause.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p3">6. Thy maid is in thy hand - Though she was his wife, he
would not countenance her in any thing disrespectful to Sarai. Those who
would keep up peace and love, must return first answers to hard
accusations; husbands and wives particularly should endeavour not to be
both angry together. And when Sarai dealt hardly with her - Making her
to serve with rigor; she fled from her face - She not only avoided her
wrath for the present, but totally deserted her service.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p4">7. Here is the first mention we have in scripture of an
angel's appearance, who arrested her in her flight. It should seem she
was making towards her own country, for she was in the way to Shur,
which lay towards Egypt. 'Twere well if our afflictions would make us
think of our home, the better county. But Hagar was now out of the way
of her duty, and going farther astray, when the angel found her. It is a
great mercy to be stopt in a sinful way, either by conscience or
providence.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p5">8. And he said, Hagar, Sarai's maid -</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p6">1. As a check to her pride. Though she was
Abram's wife, yet he calls her Sarai's maid to humble her.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p7">2. As a rebuke to her flight. Sarai's maid
ought to be in Sarai's tent, and not wandering in the wilderness. Whence
comest thou - Consider that thou art running away both from the duty
thou wast bound to, and the privileges thou wast blest with, in Abram's
tent. And Whither wilt thou go? - Thou art running thyself into sin in
Egypt; if she return to that people, she will return to their gods. And
she said, I flee from the face of my mistress - She acknowledges her
fault in fleeing from her mistress; and yet, excuses it, that it was
from the face, or displeasure, of her mistress.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p8">9. And the angel said, Return to thy mistress, and submit
thyself under her hand - Go home and humble thyself for what thou hast
done amiss, and resolve for the future to behave thyself better.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p9">10. I will multiply thy seed exceedingly - Hebrew.
multiplying I will multiply it, that is, multiply it in every age, so as
to perpetuate it. 'Tis supposed that the Turks at this day descended
from Ishmael, and they are a great people.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p10">11. Ishmael, that is, God will hear; and the reason is,
because the Lord hath heard: he hath, and therefore he will. The
experience we have had of God's seasonable kindness in distress should
encourage us to hope for the like help in the like exigencies. Even
there, where there is little cry of devotion, the God of pity hears the
cry of affliction: tears speak as well as prayers.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p11">12. He will be a wild man - A wild ass of a man, so the
word is: rude, and bold and fearing no man; untamed, untractable, living
at large, and impatient of service and restraint. His hand will be
against every man - That is his sin, and every man's hand against him -
That is his punishment. Note, Those that have turbulent spirits have
commonly troublesome lives: they that are provoking, and injurious to
others, must expect to be repaid in their own coin. And yet, he shall
dwell in the presence of all his brethren -- though threatened and
insulted by all his neighbours, yet he shall keep his ground, and, for
Abram's sake more than his own, shall be able to make his part good with
them. Accordingly we read, chap. xxv, 18, that he died, as he lived, in
the presence of all his brethren.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p12">13. And she called the name of the Lord that spake unto
her - That is, thus she made confession of his name, Thou God seest me -
This should be with her, his name forever, and this his memorial, by
which she will know him, and remember him while she lives, Thou God
seest me. Thou seest my sorrow and affliction. This Hagar especially
refers to: when we have brought ourselves into distress by our own
folly, yet God has not forsaken us. Thou seest the sincerity of my
repentance. Thou seest me, if in any instance I depart from thee. This
thought should always restrain us from sin, and excite us to duty, Thou
God seest me. Have I here also looked after him that seeth me? -
Probably she knew not who it was that talked with her till he was
departing, and then looking after him, with a reflexion like that of the
two disciples, <scripRef passage="Luke xxiv. 31, 32" id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Luke|24|31|24|32" osisRef="Bible:Luke.24.31-Luke.24.32">Luke xxiv, 31,
32</scripRef>. Here also - Not only in Abram's tent, and at his altar, but
here also, in this wilderness: here, where I never expected it, where I
was out of the way of my duty?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xvii.ii-p13">14. The well was called Beer-lahai-roi - The well of him
that lives and sees me. 'Tis likely Hagar put this name upon it, and it
was retained long after. This was the place where the God of glory
manifested the special care he took of a poor woman in distress. Those
that are graciously admitted into communion with God, and receive
seasonable comforts from him, should tell others what he has done for
their souls, that they also may be encouraged to seek him and trust in
him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="34.14%" prev="ii.ii.xvii.ii" next="ii.ii.xviii.i" id="ii.ii.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XVII" id="ii.ii.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 17" progress="34.14%" prev="ii.ii.xviii" next="ii.ii.xviii.ii" id="ii.ii.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.i-p1">This chapter contains articles of agreement betwixt the
great Jehovah, the father of mercies, and pious Abram, the father of the
faithful. Mention was made of this covenant, chap. xv, 18. but here it
is particularly drawn up. Here are,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xviii.i-p2">I. The circumstances of the making of this
covenant, the time and manner, ver. 1. and the posture Abram was in,
ver. 3.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xviii.i-p3">II. The covenant itself, in the particular
instances.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xviii.i-p4">1. That he should be the father of many
nations, ver.4. 6. and in token of that his name was changed, ver.
5.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xviii.i-p5">2. That God would be a God to him and his
seed, and would give them the land of Canaan, ver. 7, 8. and the seal of
this part of the covenant was circumcision, ver. 9-14.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xviii.i-p6">3. That he should have a son by Sarai, and
in token of that her name was changed, ver. 15, 16. This promise Abraham
received, ver. 17. And his request for Ishmael, (ver. 18.) was answered
abundantly to his satisfaction, ver. 19-22.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xviii.i-p7">III. The circumcision of Abraham and his
family, according to God's appointment, ver. 23-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 17" progress="34.16%" prev="ii.ii.xviii.i" next="ii.ii.xix" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p1">1. And when Abram was ninety nine years old - Full
thirteen years after the birth of Ishmael. So long the promise of Isaac
was deferred;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p2">1. Perhaps to correct Abram's over-hasty
marrying of Hagar.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p3">2. That Abram and Sarai being so far
striken in age, God's power in this matter might be the more magnified.
The Lord appeared unto Abram - In some visible display of God's
immediate glorious presence with him. And said, I am the Almighty God -
By this name he chose to make himself known to Abram, rather than by his
name Jehovah, <scripRef passage="Exod. vi. 3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Exod|6|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.6.3">Exod. vi, 3</scripRef>. He used it to Jacob, chap. xxxv, 11. They called him by
this name, chap. xxviii, 5; xliii, 14; xlviii, 3. It is the name of God
that is mostly used throughout the book of Job, at least 30 times in the
discourses of that book, in which Jehovah is used but once. After Moses,
Jehovah is more frequently used, and this very rarely. I am El-Shaddai.
It speaks the almighty power of God, either</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p4">1. As an avenger, from |wrv| he destroyed,
or laid waste; so some: and they think God took this title from the
destruction of the old world: Or,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p5">2. As a benefactor, |v| for |rva| who, and
|yr| it sufficeth. Our old English translation reads it here, very
significantly, I am God All- sufficient. The God with whom we have to
do, is self-sufficient; he hath every thing, and he needs not any thing.
And he is enough to us, if we be in covenant with him; we have all in
him, and we have enough in him; enough to satisfy our most enlarged
desires; enough to supply the defect of every thing else, and to secure
us happiness for our immortal souls. But the covenant is mutual, walk
before me, and be thou perfect - That is, upright and sincere.
Observe,</p>

<p class="List5" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p6">1. That to walk before God, is to set God
always before us, and to think, and speak, and act, in every thing as
those that are always under his eye. It is to have a constant regard to
his word, as our rule, and to his glory, as our end, in all our actions.
It is to be inward with him in all the duties of religious worship, and
to be entire for him in all holy conversation.</p>

<p class="List5" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p7">2. That upright walking with God is the
condition of our interest in his all-sufficiency. If we neglect him, or
dissemble with him, we forfeit the benefit of our relation to him.</p>

<p class="List5" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p8">3. A continual regard to God's
all-sufficiency will have a great influence upon our upright walking
with him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p9">3. And Abram fell on his face while God talked with him -
Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p10">1. As one overcome by the brightness of the
Divine glory: Daniel and John did so likewise. Or.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p11">2. As one ashamed of himself, and blushing
to think of the honours done to one so unworthy. He looks upon himself
with humility, and upon God with reverence, and, in token of both, falls
on his face.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p12">4. The promise is here introduced with solemnity: As for
me, saith the Great God, Behold, behold and admire it, behold and be
assured of it, my covenant is with thee. And thou shalt be a father of
many nations - This implies,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p13">1. That his seed after the flesh should be
very numerous, both in Isaac and in Ishmael, and in the sons of Keturah.
And the event answered, for there have been, and are, more of the
children of men descended from Abraham, than from any one man at equal
distance with him from Noah, the common root.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p14">2. That all believers, in every age, should
be looked upon as his spiritual seed, as the father of the faithful. In
this sense the apostle directs us to understand this promise, <scripRef passage="Rom. iv. 16, 17" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Rom|4|16|4|17" osisRef="Bible:Rom.4.16-Rom.4.17">Rom. iv, 16, 17</scripRef>. He is the father of those, in every nation, that, by faith,
enter into covenant with God, and (as the Jewish writers express it) are
gathered under the wings of the divine majesty.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p15">5. In token of this, his name was changed from Abram, a
high father, to Abraham, the father of a multitude. This was to confirm
the faith of Abraham, while he was childless; perhaps even his own name
was sometimes an occasion of grief to him; Why should he be called a
high father, who was not a father at all? But now God had promised him a
numerous issue, and had given him a name which signified so much; that
name was his joy.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p16">7. And I will establish my covenant - Not to be altered
or revoked; not with thee only, then it would die with thee but with thy
seed after thee; and it is not only thy seed after the flesh, but thy
spiritual seed. It is everlasting in the evangelical meaning of it. The
covenant of grace is everlasting; it is from everlasting in the counsels
of it, and to everlasting in the consequences of it; and the external
administration of it is transmitted, with the seal of it, to the seed of
believers, and the internal administration of it by the Spirit to
Christ's seed in every age. This is a covenant of exceeding great and
precious promises. Here are two which indeed are all-sufficient, that
God would be their God. All the privileges of the covenant, all its
joys, and all its hopes, are summed up in this. A man needs desire no
more than this to make him happy. What God is himself, that he will be
to his people: wisdom to guide and counsel them, power to protect and
support them, goodness to supply and comfort them; what faithful
worshippers can expect from the God they serve, believers shall find in
God as theirs. This is enough, yet not all.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p17">8. And I will give thee Canaan for an everlasting
possession - God had before promised this land to Abraham and his seed,
ver. 18. But here, it is promised for an everlasting possession, as a
type of heaven, that everlasting rest which remains for the people of
God. This is that better country to which Abraham had an eye, and the
grant of which was that which answered the vast extent of that promise,
that God would be to them a God; so that if God had not designed this,
he would have been ashamed to be called their God, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 16" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Heb|11|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.16">Heb. xi, 16</scripRef>. As the land of Canaan was secured to the seed of Abraham,
according to the flesh; so heaven is secured to all his spiritual seed
for a possession truly everlasting. The offer of this eternal life is
made in the word, and confirmed by the sacraments, to all that are under
the external administration of the covenant, and the earnest of it is
given to all believers.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p18">10. The token of the covenant, is circumcision, for the
sake of which the covenant is itself called the covenant of
circumcision, <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 8" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Acts|7|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.8">Acts vii, 8</scripRef>. It is here said to be the covenant which Abraham and his
seed must keep, as a copy or counterpart, it is called a sign and seal, <scripRef passage="Rom. iv. 11" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p18.2" parsed="|Rom|4|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.4.11">Rom. iv, 11</scripRef>, for it was.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p19">1. A confirmation to Abraham and his seed
of those promises which were God's part of the covenant, assuring them
that, in due time, Canaan should be theirs: and the continuance of this
ordinance, after Canaan was theirs, intimates, that that promise looked
farther, to another Canaan.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p20">2. An obligation upon Abraham and his seed
to that duty which was their part of the covenant, not only to the duty
of accepting the covenants and putting away the corruption of the flesh,
which were primarily signified by circumcision, but in general to the
observation of all God's commands. They who will have God to be to them
a God, must consent to be to him a people. Now,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p21">1. Circumcision was a bloody ordinance, for
all things by the law were purged with blood, <scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 22" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p21.1" parsed="|Heb|9|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.22">Heb. ix, 22</scripRef>. See <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiv. 8" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p21.2" parsed="|Exod|24|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.24.8">Exod. xxiv, 8</scripRef>. But the blood of Christ being shed, all bloody ordinances
are now abolished. Circumcision therefore gives way to baptism.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p22">2. It was peculiar to the males, though the
women also were included in the covenant.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p23">3. Christ having not yet offered himself
for us, God would have man to enter into covenant, by the offering of
some part of his own body, and no part could be better spared.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p24">4. The ordinance was to be administered to
children when they were eight days old, that they might gather some
strength to be able to undergo the pain of it.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p25">5. The children of the strangers were to be
circumcised, which looked favourable upon the Gentiles, who should, in
due time be brought into the family of Abraham, by faith. Here is, (1.)
The promise made to Abraham of a son by Sarai, that son in whom the
promise made to him should be fulfilled, that he should be the father of
many nations, for she also shall be a mother of nations, and kings of
people shall be of her, ver. 16. Note,</p>

<p class="List5" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p26">1. God reveals the purposes of his goodwill
to his people by degrees. God had told Abraham long before, that he
should have a son, but never 'till now that he should have a son by
Sarai.</p>

<p class="List5" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p27">2. The blessing of the Lord makes fruitful,
and adds no sorrow with it; no such sorrow as was in Hagar's case. I
will bless her, with the blessing of fruitfulness, and then thou shalt
have a son of her.</p>

<p class="List5" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p28">3. Civil government and order is a great
blessing to the church. It is promised not only that people, but kings
of people should be of her; not a headless rout, but a well modelled,
well governed society.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p29">15. Sarah shall her name be - The same letter is added to
her name that was to Abraham's. Sarai signifies my princess, as if her
honour were confined to one family only: Sarah signifies a princess,
viz. of multitudes.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p30">17. Then Abraham fell on his face, and laughed - It was a
laughter of delight, not of distrust. Now it was that Abraham rejoiced
to see Christ's day, now he saw it and was glad, <scripRef passage="John viii. 56" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p30.1" parsed="|John|8|56|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.8.56">John viii, 56</scripRef>, for as he saw heaven in the promise of Canaan, so he saw
Christ in the promise of Isaac, and said, Shall a child be born to him
that is an hundred years old? - He doth not here speak of it, as at all
doubtful, for we are sure he staggered not at the promise, <scripRef passage="Rom. iv. 20" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p30.2" parsed="|Rom|4|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.4.20">Rom. iv, 20</scripRef>, but as wonderful, and that which could not be effected but
by the almighty power of God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p31">18. And Abraham said, O that Ishmael might live before
thee! - This he speaks nor as desiring that Ishmael might be preferred
before the son he should have by Sarah, but as dreading lest he should
be forsaken of God, he puts up this petition on his behalf. The great
thing we should desire of God, for our children, is, that they may live
before him, that is, that they may be kept in covenant with him, and may
have grace to walk before him in their uprightness. God's answer to this
prayer, is an answer of peace. Abraham could not say he sought God's
face in vain.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p32">20. As for Ishmael, I have heard thee; I have blessed him
- That is, I have many blessings in store for him.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p33">1. His posterity shall be numerous; I will
multiply him exceedingly;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p34">2. They shall be considerable; twelve
princes shall he beget. We may charitably hope that spiritual blessings
also were bestowed upon him, though the visible church was not brought
out of his loins.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xviii.ii-p35">21. He names that child, Isaac - Laughter, because
Abraham rejoiced in spirit when this son was promised him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="34.35%" prev="ii.ii.xviii.ii" next="ii.ii.xix.i" id="ii.ii.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XVIII" id="ii.ii.xix-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 18" progress="34.35%" prev="ii.ii.xix" next="ii.ii.xix.ii" id="ii.ii.xix.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xix.i-p1">We have an account in this chapter of another interview
between God and Abraham, probably within a few days after the former, as
the reward of his chearful obedience to the law of circumcision. Here
is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xix.i-p2">I. The visit which God made him, ver.
1-8</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xix.i-p3">II. The matters discoursed of between
them,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xix.i-p4">1. The purposes of God's love concerning
Sarah, ver. 9-15.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xix.i-p5">2. The purposes of God's wrath concerning
Sodom. (1.) The discovery God made to Abraham of his design to destroy
Sodom, ver. 16-22. (2.) The intercession Abraham made for Sodom, ver.
23-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 18" progress="34.36%" prev="ii.ii.xix.i" next="ii.ii.xx" id="ii.ii.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p1">1. This appearance of God to Abraham seems to have had in
it more of freedom and familiarity, and less of grandeur and majesty,
than those we have hitherto read of, and therefore more resembles that
great visit which in the fulness of time the Son of God was to make to
the world. He sat in the tent-door in the heat of the day - Not so much
to repose himself, as to seek an opportunity of doing good, by giving
entertainment to strangers.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p2">2. And lo three men - These three men were three
spiritual heavenly beings, now assuming human shapes, that they might be
visible to Abraham, and conversable with him. Some think they were all
three created angels; others, that one of them was the Son of God. He
bowed himself towards the ground - Religion doth not destroy but improve
good manners, and teaches us to honour all men.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p3">9. Where is Sarah thy wife? - By naming her, they gave
intimation to Abraham, that tho' they seemed strangers, yet they well
knew him and his family: by enquiring after her, they shewed a kind
concern for the family of one, whom they found respectful to them. And
by speaking of her, she over-hearing it, they drew her to listen to what
was farther to be said.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p4">10. I will certainly return unto thee - And visit thee.
God will return to those that bid him welcome.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p5">12. Sarah laughed within herself - It was not a laughter
of faith, like Abraham's, chap. xvii, 17, but a laughter of doubting and
distrust. The great objection which Sarah could not get over was her
age. I am waxed old, and past child-bearing in a course of nature,
especially having been hitherto barren, and which magnifies the
difficulty, My Lord is old also. Observe here, That Sarah calls Abraham
her Lord, and the Holy Ghost takes notice of it to her honour, and
recommends it to the imitation of all Christian wives, <scripRef passage="1Pe iii. 6" id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p5.1" parsed="|1Pet|3|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.3.6">1Pe iii, 6</scripRef>. Sarah obeyed Abraham calling him Lord, in token of respect
and subjection.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p6">17. Shall I hide from Abraham that thing which I do -
Thus doth God in his councils express himself after the manner of men,
with deliberation. The secret of the Lord is with them that fear him.
Those that by faith live a life of communion with God, cannot but know
more of his mind than other people. They have a better insight into what
is present, and a better foresight of what is to come.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p7">19. I know Abraham that he will command his children, and
his household after him - This is a bright part of Abraham's character.
He not only prayed with his family, but he taught them, as a man of
knowledge; nay, he commanded them as a man in authority, and was prophet
and king, as well as priest, in his own house. And he not only took care
of his children, but of his household: his servants were catechized
servants. Masters of families should instruct, and inspect the manners
of all under their roof. And this is given as the reason why God would
make known to him his purpose concerning Sodom; because he was
communicative of his knowledge, and improved it for the benefit of those
that were under his charge.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p8">21. I will go down now and see - Not as if there were any
thing concerning which God is in doubt; but he is pleased thus to
express himself after the manner of men.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p9">23. Abraham drew near - This expression intimates, A holy
concern. A holy confidence; he drew near with an assurance of faith,
drew near as a prince, <scripRef passage="Job xxxi. 37" id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Job|31|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.31.37">Job xxxi,
37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p10">27. Behold now, I have taken upon me to speak unto the
Lord, who am but dust and ashes - He speaks as one amazed at his own
boldness, and the liberty God graciously allowed him, considering God's
greatness, he is the Lord; and his own meanness, but dust and ashes.
Whenever we draw near to God, it becomes us reverently to acknowledge
the vast distance that there is between us and Him. He is the Lord of
glory, we are worms of the earth.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p11">30. Oh let not the Lord be angry - The importunity which
believers use in their addresses to God is such, that if they were
dealing with a man like themselves, they could not but fear that he
would be angry with them. But he with whom we have to do is God and not
man, and he is pleased when he is wrestled with. But why then did
Abraham leave off asking when he had prevailed so far as to get the
place spared if there were but ten righteous in it? Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p12">1. Because he owned that it deserved to
perish if there were not so many: as the dresser of the vineyard, who
consented that the barren tree should be cut down if one year's trial
more did not make it fruitful, <scripRef passage="Luke xiii. 9" id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Luke|13|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.13.9">Luke
xiii, 9</scripRef>. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p13">2. Because God restrained his spirit from
asking any further. When God hath determined the ruin of a place, he
forbids it to be prayed for, <scripRef passage="Jer. vii. 16" id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Jer|7|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.7.16">Jer. vii,
16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xix.ii-p14">33. Abraham returned into his place - To wait what the
event would be; and it proved that his prayer was heard, and yet Sodom
not spared, because there were not ten righteous in it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="34.44%" prev="ii.ii.xix.ii" next="ii.ii.xx.i" id="ii.ii.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XIX" id="ii.ii.xx-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 19" progress="34.44%" prev="ii.ii.xx" next="ii.ii.xx.ii" id="ii.ii.xx.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xx.i-p1">We read, chap. 18. of God's coming to take a view of the
state of Sodom, what its wickedness was, and what righteous there were
in it: here we have the result of that enquiry.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xx.i-p2">I. It was found upon trial that Lot was
very good, ver. 1, 2, 3. and it did not appear that there were any more
of the same character.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xx.i-p3">II. It was found that the Sodomites were
very wicked, ver. 4-11.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xx.i-p4">III. Special care was therefore taken for
the securing of Lot and his family, ver, 12-23.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xx.i-p5">IV. The ruin of Sodom, and of Lot's wife,
ver. 24-26. with a general repetition of the story, ver. 27-29.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xx.i-p6">V. A foul sin that Lot was guilty of, in
committing incest with his two daughters, ver. 30-38.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 19" progress="34.45%" prev="ii.ii.xx.i" next="ii.ii.xxi" id="ii.ii.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p1">1. And there came two - Probably two of the three that
had just before been with Abraham, the two created angels who were sent
to execute God's purpose concerning Sodom.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p2">3. And he pressed upon them greatly - Partly because he
would by no means have them to expose themselves to the perils of
lodging in the streets of Sodom, and partly because he was desirous of
their converse.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p3">4. Here were old and young all from every quarter - The
old were not past it, and the young were soon come up to it. Either they
had no magistrates to protect the peaceable, or their magistrates were
themselves aiding and abetting.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p4">8. I have two daughters - This was unadvisedly and
unjustifiably offered. It is true, of two evils we must chose the less,
but of two sins we must chose neither, nor ever do evil that good may
come of it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p5">11. And they smote the men with blindness - This was
designed to put an end to their attempt, and to be an earnest of their
utter ruin the next day.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p6">13. We will destroy this place - The holy angels are
ministers of God's wrath for the destruction of sinners, as well as of
his mercy for the preservation and deliverance of his people.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p7">14. Up, get you out this place - The manner of expression
is startling. It was not time to trifle, when the destruction was just
at the door. But he seemed to them as one that mocked - They thought
perhaps that the assault which the Sodomites had just now made upon his
house had disturbed his head, and put him into such a fright that be
knew not what he said. They that made a jest of every thing, made a jest
of that, and so perished in the overthrow. Thus many who are warned of
the danger they are in by sin, make a light matter of it; such will
perish with their blood upon their heads.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p8">16. Tho' Lot did not make a jest of the warning as his
sons-in-law, yet he lingered, he did not make so much haste as the case
required. And it might have been fatal to him, if the angels had not
laid hold on his hand, and brought him forth. Herein the Lord was
merciful to him, otherwise he might justly have left him to perish,
since he was loath to depart. If God had not been merciful to us, our
lingering had been our ruin.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p9">17. Look not behind thee - He must not loiter by the way;
stay not in all the plain - For it would all be made one dead sea: he
must not take up short of the place of refuge appointed him; escape to
the mountain - Such as these are the commands given to those who through
grace are delivered out of a sinful state.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p10">1. Return not to sin and Satan, for that's
looking back to Sodom.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p11">2. Rest not in the world, for that's
staying in the plain. And,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p12">3. Reach toward Christ and heaven, for that
is escaping to the mountain, short of which we must not take up.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p13">22. I cannot do any thing till thou be come thither - The
very presence of good men in a place helps to keep off judgments. See
what care God takes for the preservation of his people!</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p14">24. Then the Lord rained - from the Lord - God the Son,
from God the Father, for the Father has committed all judgment to the
Son. He that is the saviour will be the destroyer of those that reject
the salvation.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p15">25. And he overthrew the cities, and all the inhabitants
of them, the plain, and all that grew upon the ground - It was an utter
ruin, and irreparable; that fruitful valley remains to this day a great
lake, or dead sea. Travelers say it is about thirty miles long, and ten
miles broad. It has no living creature in it: it is not moved by the
wind: the smell of it is offensive: things do not easily sink in it. The
Greeks call it Asphaltis, from a sort of pitch which it casts up. Jordan
falls into it, and is lost there. It was a punishment that answered
their sin. Burning lusts against nature were justly punished with this
preternatural burning.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p16">26. But his wife looked back from behind him - Herein she
disobeyed an express command. Probably she hankered after her house and
goods in Sodom, and was loath to leave them. Christ intimates this to be
her sin, <scripRef passage="Luke xvii. 31, 32" id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Luke|17|31|17|32" osisRef="Bible:Luke.17.31-Luke.17.32">Luke xvii, 31,
32</scripRef>, she too much regarded her stuff. And her looking back spoke
an inclination to go back; and therefore our saviour uses it as a
warning against apostasy from our Christian profession. And she became a
pillar of salt - She was struck dead in the place, yet her body did not
fall down, but stood fixed and erect like a pillar or monument, not
liable to waste or decay, as human bodies exposed to the air are, but
metamorphosed into a metallic substance, which would last perpetually.
Our communion with God consists in our gracious regard to him, and his
gracious regard to us. We have here therefore the communion that was
between God and Abraham in the event concerning Sodom, as before in the
consultation concerning It; for communion with God is to be kept up in
providences as well as in ordinances.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p17">27. And Abraham gat up early - And to see what was become
of his prayers, he went to the very place were he had stood before the
Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p18">28. And he looked toward Sodom - Not as Lot's wife did,
tacitly reflecting upon the divine severity, but humbly adoring it, and
acquiescing in it. Here is God's favourable regard to Abraham, ver. 29.
As before when Abraham prayed for Ishmael, God heard him for Isaac, so
now when he prayed for Sodom, he heard for Lot.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p19">29. God remembered Abraham, and for his sake sent Lot out
of the overthrow - God will certainly give an answer of peace to the
prayer of faith in his own way and time.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xx.ii-p20">30. He feared to dwell in Zoar - Here is the great
trouble and distress that Lot was brought into after his deliverance,
ver. 29. He was frightened out of Zoar, durst not dwell there, either
because he was conscious to himself that it was a refuge of his own
chusing, and that therein he had foolishly prescribed to God, and
therefore could not but distrust his safety in it. Probably he found it
as wicked as Sodom; and therefore concluded it could not long survive
it; or perhaps he observed the rise and increase of those waters, which,
after the conflagration, began to overflow the plain, and which, mixing
with the ruins, by degrees made the dead sea; in those waters he
concluded Zoar must needs perish, (though it had escaped the fire)
because it stood upon the same flat. He was now glad to go to the
mountain, the place which God had appointed for his shelter. See in Lot
what those bring themselves to at last, that forsake the communion of
saints for secular advantages.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="34.57%" prev="ii.ii.xx.ii" next="ii.ii.xxi.i" id="ii.ii.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XX" id="ii.ii.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 20" progress="34.57%" prev="ii.ii.xxi" next="ii.ii.xxi.ii" id="ii.ii.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.i-p1">We have here,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxi.i-p2">I. Abraham's sin in denying his wife, and
Abimelech's sin thereupon in taking her, ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxi.i-p3">II. God's discourse with Abimelech in a
dream upon this occasion; wherein he shews him his error, ver. 3.
accepts his plea, ver. 4, 5, 6. and directs him to make restitution,
ver. 7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxi.i-p4">III. Abimelech's discourse with Abraham;
wherein he chides him for the cheat he had put upon him, ver. 8, 9, 10.
and Abraham excuses it as well as he can, ver. 11, 12, 13.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxi.i-p5">IV. The good issue of the story; in which
Abimelech restores Abraham his wife, ver. 14, 15, 16. and Abraham by
prayer prevails with God for the removal of the judgment Abimelech was
under, ver. 17, 18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 20" progress="34.58%" prev="ii.ii.xxi.i" next="ii.ii.xxii" id="ii.ii.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p1">1. And Abraham sojourned in Gerar - We are not told upon
what occasion he removed, whether terrified by the destruction of Sodom,
or, as some of the Jewish writers say, because he was grieved at Lot's
incest with his daughters, and the reproach which the Canaanites cast
upon him for his kinsman's sake. The king of Gerar sent and took her -
To his house, in order to the taking of her to his bed.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p2">3. But God came to Abimelech in a dream - It appears by
this that God revealed himself by dreams, which evidenced themselves to
be divine and supernatural, not only to his servants the prophets, but
even to those that were out of the pale of the church; but then usually
it was with some regard to God's own people.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p3">4. Wilt thou slay also a righteous nation - Not such a
nation as Sodom.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p4">6. I withheld thee from sinning against me - It is God
that restrains men from doing the ill they would do; it is not from him
that there is sin, but it is from him that there is not more sin, either
by his influence on mens minds checking their inclination to sin, or by
his providence taking away the opportunity. It is a great mercy to be
hindered from committing sin, which God must have the glory of whoever
is the instrument.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p5">9. Thou hast done deeds that ought not to be done -
Equivocation and dissimulation, however they may be palliated, are very
ill things, and by no means to be admitted in any case. He takes it as a
very great injury to himself and his family, that Abraham had thus
exposed them to sin, What have I offended thee? - If I had been thy
worst enemy, thou couldst not have done me a worse turn, nor taken a
more effectual course to be avenged on me. Note, We ought to reckon,
that those do us the greatest dislikedness in the world, that any way
tempt us or expose us to sin, though they may pretend friendship, and
offer that which is grateful enough to the corrupt nature. He challenges
him to assign any just cause he had to suspect them as a dangerous
people for an honest man to live among.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p6">10. What sawest thou that thou hast done this thing -
What reason hadst thou to think, that if we had known her to be thy
wife, thou wouldst have been exposed to any danger by it?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p7">11. I thought surely the fear of God is not in this
place, and they will slay me - There are many places and persons that
have more of the fear of God in them than we think they have; perhaps
they are not called by our name, they do not wear our badges, they do
not tie themselves to that which we have an opinion of; and therefore we
conclude they have not the fear of God in their hearts!</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p8">13. When God caused me to wander from my father's house -
Then we settled this matter. It may be, that God denied Abraham and
Sarah the blessing of children so long to punish them for this sinful
compact they had made to deny one another: if they will not own their
marriage, why should God own it? But we may suppose, that alter this
reproof they agreed never to do so again, and then presently we read,
chap. xxi, 1, 2, that Sarah conceived.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p9">16. Thy brother is to thee a covering of the eyes - Thou
must look at no other, nor desire to be looked at by any other.
Yoke-fellows must be to each other for a covering of the eyes. The
marriage- covenant is a covenant with the eyes, like Job's, <scripRef passage="Job xxxi. 1" id="ii.ii.xxi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Job|31|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.31.1">Job xxxi, 1</scripRef>.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="34.64%" prev="ii.ii.xxi.ii" next="ii.ii.xxii.i" id="ii.ii.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXI" id="ii.ii.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 21" progress="34.64%" prev="ii.ii.xxii" next="ii.ii.xxii.ii" id="ii.ii.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.i-p1">In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxii.i-p2">I. Isaac, the child of promise, born into
Abraham's family, ver. 1- 8.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxii.i-p3">II. Ishmael, the son of the bond-woman,
cast out of it, ver. 9-21.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxii.i-p4">III. Abraham's league with Abimelech, ver.
22-32.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxii.i-p5">IV. His devotion to God, ver. 33, 34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 21" progress="34.64%" prev="ii.ii.xxii.i" next="ii.ii.xxiii" id="ii.ii.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p1">2. Sarah conceived - Sarah by faith, received strength to
conceive, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 11" id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Heb|11|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.11">Heb. xi, 11</scripRef>. God therefore, by promise, gave that strength. Abraham was
old, and Sarah old, and both as good as dead, and then the word of God
took place.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p2">4. He circumcised his son - The covenant being
established with him, the seal of the covenant was administered to
him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p3">6. And Sarah said, God has made me to laugh - He hath
given me both cause to rejoice, and a heart to rejoice. And it adds to
the comfort of any mercy to have our friends rejoice with us in it, See <scripRef passage="Luke i. 58" id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Luke|1|58|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1.58">Luke i, 58</scripRef>. They that hear will laugh with me - Others will rejoice in
this instance of God's power and goodness, and be encouraged to trust in
him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p4">9. Sarah saw the son of the Egyptian mocking - Mocking
Isaac no doubt, for it is sad, with reference to this, <scripRef passage="Gal. iv. 29" id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Gal|4|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.4.29">Gal. iv, 29</scripRef>, that he that was born after the flesh, persecuted him that
was born after the spirit. Ishmael is here called the son of the
Egyptian, because (as some think) the four hundred years affliction of
the seed of Abraham by the Egyptians began now, and was to be dated from
hence.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p5">10. Cast out the bond-woman - This was a type of the
rejection of the unbelieving Jews, who, though they were the seed of
Abraham, yet, because they submitted not to the gospel-covenant, were
unchurched and disfranchised. And that, which above any thing provoked
God to cast them off, was, their mocking and persecuting the
gospel-church, God's Isaac, in his infancy.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p6">11. The thing was very grievous in Abraham's sight - it
grieved him that Ishmael had given such provocation. And still more that
Sarah insisted upon such a punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p7">13. The casting out of Ishmael was not his ruin. He shall
be a nation because he is thy seed - We are not sure that it was his
eternal ruin. It is presumption to say, that all these who are left out
of the external dispensation of God's covenant are excluded from all his
mercies. Those may be saved who are not thus honoured.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p8">14. And Abraham rose up early in the morning - We may
suppose immediately after he had in the night-visions received orders to
do this.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p9">17. God heard the voice of the lad - We read not of a
word be said; but his sighs and groans, cried loud in the ears of the
God of mercy. An angel was sent to comfort Hagar, who assures her, God
has heard the voice of the lad where he is - Though he be in the
wilderness; for wherever we are, there is a way open heavenwards;
therefore lift up the lad, and hold him in thy hand - God's readiness to
help us when we are in trouble must not slacken, but quicken our
endeavours to help ourselves. He repeats the promise concerning her son,
that he should be a great nation, as a reason why she should bestir
herself to help him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p10">31. Beer-sheba - That is, the well of the oath, in
remembrance of the covenant that they swear to, that they might be ever
mindful of it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxii.ii-p11">33. And Abraham planted a grove - For a shade to his
tent, or perhaps an orchard of fruit trees; and there, though we cannot
say he settled, for God would have him while he lived to be a stranger
and a pilgrim, yet he sojourned many days. And called there on the name
of the Lord - Probably in the grove he planted, which was his oratory,
or house of prayer: he kept up publick worship, to which probably his
neighbours resorted, and joined with him. Men should not only retain
their goodness wherever they go, but do all they can to propagate it,
and make others good. The everlasting God - Though God had made himself
known to Abraham as his God in particular; yet he forgets not to give
glory to him as the Lord of all, the everlasting God, who was before all
worlds, and will be when time and days shall be no more.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="34.71%" prev="ii.ii.xxii.ii" next="ii.ii.xxiii.i" id="ii.ii.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXII" id="ii.ii.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 22" progress="34.71%" prev="ii.ii.xxiii" next="ii.ii.xxiii.ii" id="ii.ii.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.i-p1">We have here,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxiii.i-p2">I. The strange command which God gave to
Abraham, ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxiii.i-p3">II. Abraham's strange obedience to this
command, ver. 3-10.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxiii.i-p4">III. The strange issue of this trial. (1.)
The sacrificing of Isaac was countermanded, ver. 11, 12. (2.) Another
sacrifice was provided, ver. 13, 14. (3.) The covenant was renewed with
Abraham hereupon, ver. 15- 19.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxiii.i-p5">IV. An account of some of Abraham's
relations, ver. 20-24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 22" progress="34.71%" prev="ii.ii.xxiii.i" next="ii.ii.xxiv" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p1">1. Here is the trial of Abraham's faith, whether it
continued so strong, so vigourous, so victorious, after a long
settlement in communion with God, as it was at first, when by it he left
his country: then it appeared that he loved God better than his father;
now, that he loved him better than his son. After these things - After
all the other exercises he had had, all the difficulties he had gone
through: now perhaps he was beginning to think the storms were blown
over but after all, this encounter comes, which is stranger than any
yet. God did tempt Abraham - Not to draw him to sin, so Satan tempts;
but to discover his graces, how strong they were, that they might be
found to praise and honour and glory. The trial itself: God appeared to
him as he had formerly done, called him by name Abraham, that name which
had been given him in ratification of the promise: Abraham, like a good
servant, readily answered, Here am I; what saith my Lord unto his
servant? Probably he expected some renewed promise, like those, chap.
xv, 1; xvii, 1, but to his great amazement that which God hath to say to
him is in short, Abraham, go kill thy son: and this command is given him
in such aggravating language as makes the temptation abundantly more
grievous. When God speaks, Abraham, no doubt, takes notice of every
word, and listens attentively to it: and every word here is a sword in
his bones; the trial is steel'd with trying phrases. Is it any pleasure
to the Almighty that he should afflict? No, it is not; yet when
Abraham's faith is to be tried, God seems to take pleasure in the
aggravation of the trial.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p2">2. And he said, take thy son - Not thy bullocks and thy
lambs; how willingly would Abraham have parted with them by thousands to
redeem Isaac! Not thy servant, no, not the steward of thine house. Thine
only son - Thine only son by Sarah. Ishmael was lately cast out, to the
grief of Abraham, and now Isaac only was left and must he go too? Yes:
take Isaac, him by name, thy laughter, that son indeed. Yea, that son
whom thou lovest - The trial was of Abraham's love to God, and therefore
it must be in a beloved son: in the Hebrew 'tis expressed more
emphatically, and I think might very well be read thus, Take now that
son of thine, that only son of thine, whom thou lovest, that Isaac. And
get thee into the land of Moriah - Three days journey off: so that he
might have time to consider it, and if he do it, must do it
deliberately. And offer him for a burnt offering - He must not only kill
his son, but kill him as a sacrifice, with all that sedateness and
composedness of mind, with which he used to offer his burnt-
offering.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p3">3. The several steps of this obedience, all help to
magnify it, and to shew that he was guided by prudence, and governed by
faith, in the whole transaction. (1.) He rises early - Probably the
command was given in the visions of the night, and early the next
morning he sets himself about it, did not delay, did not demur. Those
that do the will of God heartily will do it speedily. (2.) He gets
things ready for a sacrifice, and it should seem, with his own hands,
cleaves the wood for the burnt-offering. (3.) He left his servants at
some distance off, left they should have created him some disturbance in
his strange oblation. Thus when Christ was entering upon his agony in
the garden, he took only three of his disciples with him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p4">6. Isaac's carrying the wood was a type of Christ, who
carried his own cross, while Abraham, with a steady and undaunted
resolution, carried the fatal knife and fire.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p5">7. Behold the fire and the wood, but where is the lamb? -
This is,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p6">1. A trying question to Abraham; how could
he endure to think that Isaac is himself the lamb?</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p7">2. 'Tis a teaching question to us all, that
when we are going to worship God, we should seriously consider whether
we have every thing ready, especially the lamb for a burnt-offering.
Behold, the fire is ready; that is, the Spirit's assistance, and God's
acceptance: the wood is ready, the instituted ordinances designed to
kindle our affections, which indeed, without the Spirit, are but like
wood without fire, but the Spirit works by them. All things are now
ready, but where is the lamb? Where is the heart? Is that ready to be
offered up to God, to ascend to him as a burnt- offering?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p8">8. My son, God will provide himself a lamb - This was the
language either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p9">1. Of his obedience; we must offer the lamb
which God has appointed now to be offered; thus giving him this general
rule of submission to the divine will to prepare him for the application
of it to himself. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p10">2. Of his faith; whether he meant it so or
no, this proved to be the meaning of it; a sacrifice was provided
instead of Isaac. Thus,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p11">1. Christ the great sacrifice of atonement
was of God's providing: when none in heaven or earth could have found a
lamb for that burnt-offering, God himself found the ransom.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p12">2. All our sacrifices of acknowledgement
are of God's providing too; 'tis he that prepares the heart. The broken
and contrite spirit is a sacrifice of God, of his providing.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p13">9. With the same resolution and composedness of mind, he
applies himself to the compleating of this sacrifice. After many a weary
step, and with a heavy heart, he arrives at length at the fatal place;
builds the altar, an altar of earth, we may suppose, the saddest that
ever be built; lays the wood in order for Isaac's funeral pile; and now
tells him the amazing news. Isaac, for ought appears, is as willing as
Abraham; we do not find that he made any objection against it. God
commands it to be done, and Isaac has learned to submit. Yet it is
necessary that a sacrifice be bound; the great Sacrifice, which, in the
fulness of time, was to be offered up, must be bound, and therefore so
must Isaac. Having bound him he lays him upon the altar, and his hand
upon the head of the sacrifice. Be astonished, O heavens, at this, and
wonder, O earth! here is an act of faith and obedience which deserves to
be a spectacle to God, angels and men; Abraham's darling, the church's
hope, the heir of promise, lies ready to bleed and die by his own
father's hands! Now this obedience of Abraham in offering up Isaac is a
lively representation,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p14">1. Of the love of God to us, in delivering
up his only begotten Son to suffer and die for us, as a sacrifice.
Abraham was obliged both in duty and gratitude to part with Isaac and
parted with him to a friend, but God was under no obligations to us, for
we were enemies.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p15">2. Of our duty to God in return of that
love we must tread in the steps of this faith of Abraham. God, by his
word, calls us to part with all for Christ, all our sins, tho' they have
been as a right hand, or a right eye, or an Isaac; all those things that
are rivals with Christ for the sovereignity of our heart; and we must
cheerfully let them all go. God, by his providence, which is truly the
voice of God, calls us to part with an Isaac sometimes, and we must do
it by a chearful resignation and submission to his holy will.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p16">11. The Angel of the Lord - That is, God himself, the
eternal Word, the Angel of the covenant, who was to be the great
Redeemer and Comforter.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p17">12. Lay not thine hand upon the lad - God's time to help
his people is, when they are brought to the greatest extremity: the more
eminent the danger is, and the nearer to be put in execution, the more
wonderful and the more welcome is the deliverance. Now know I that thou
fearest God - God knew it before, but now Abraham had given a memorable
evidence of it. He need do no more, what he had done was sufficient to
prove the religious regard he had to God and his authority. The best
evidence of our fearing God is our being willing to honour him with that
which is dearest to us, and to part with all to him, or for him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p18">13. Behold a ram - Tho' that blessed Seed was now
typified by Isaac, yet the offering of him up was suspended 'till the
latter end of the world, and in the mean time the sacrifice of beasts
was accepted, as a pledge of that expiation which should be made by that
great sacrifice. And it is observable, that the temple, the place of
sacrifice, was afterward built upon this mount Moriah, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. iii. 1" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p18.1" parsed="|2Chr|3|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.3.1">2 Chron. iii, 1</scripRef>, and mount Calvary, where Christ was crucified, was not far
off.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p19">14. And Abraham called the place Jehovah-jireh - The Lord
will provide. Probably alluding to what he had said, ver. 8. God will
provide himself a lamb - This was purely the Lord's doing: let it be
recorded for the generations to come; that the Lord will see; he will
always have his eyes upon his people in their straits, that he may come
in with seasonable succor in the critical juncture. And that he will be
seen, be seen in the mount, in the greatest perplexities of his people;
he will not only manifest but magnify his wisdom, power and goodness in
their deliverance. Where God sees and provides, he should be seen and
praised. And perhaps it may refer to God manifest in the flesh.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p20">15. And the Angel - Christ. Called unto Abraham -
Probably while the ram was yet burning. Very high expressions are here
of God's favour to Abraham, above any he had yet been blessed with.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p21">16. Because thou hast done this thing, and hast not
with-held thy son, thine only son - He lays a mighty emphasis upon that,
and ver. 18, praises it as an act of obedience, in it thou hast obeyed
my voice. By myself have I sworn - For he could swear by no greater.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p22">17. Multiplying I will multiply thee - Those that part
with any thing for God, shall have it made up to them with unspeakable
advantage. Abraham has but one son, and is willing to part with that one
in obedience to God; well, saith God, thou shalt be recompensed with
thousands and millions. Here is a promise,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p23">1. Of the Spirit, In blessing I will bless
thee - The Gift of the Holy Ghost; the promise of the Spirit was that
blessing of Abraham which was to come upon the Gentiles through Jesus
Christ, <scripRef passage="Gal. iii. 14" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p23.1" parsed="|Gal|3|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.3.14">Gal. iii, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p24">2. Of the increase of the church; that
believers, his spiritual seed, should be many as the stars of
heaven.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p25">3. Of spiritual victories; Thy seed shall
possess the gate of his enemies - Believers by their faith overcome the
world, and triumph over all the powers of darkness. Probably Zacharias
refers to this part of the oath, <scripRef passage="Luke i. 74" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p25.1" parsed="|Luke|1|74|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1.74">Luke i,
74</scripRef>. That we being delivered out of the hand of our enemies
might serve him without fear. But the crown of all is the last
promise,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p26">4. Of the incarnation of Christ; In thy
seed (one particular person that shall descend from thee, for he speaks
not of many but of one, as the apostle observes, <scripRef passage="Gal. iii. 16" id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p26.1" parsed="|Gal|3|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.3.16">Gal. iii, 16</scripRef>.) shall all the nations of the earth be blessed - Christ is
the great blessing of the world. Abraham was ready to give up his son
for a sacrifice to the honour of God, and on that occasion God promised
to give his son a sacrifice for the salvation of man.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiii.ii-p27">20. This is recorded here, 1. To show that tho' Abraham
saw his own family highly dignified with peculiar privileges, yet he did
not look with contempt upon his relations, but was glad to hear of the
increase and prosperity of their families. 2. To make way for the
following story of the marriage of Isaac to Rebekah, a daughter of this
family.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="34.91%" prev="ii.ii.xxiii.ii" next="ii.ii.xxiv.i" id="ii.ii.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXIII" id="ii.ii.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxiv-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 23" progress="34.91%" prev="ii.ii.xxiv" next="ii.ii.xxiv.ii" id="ii.ii.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxiv.i-p1">Here is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxiv.i-p2">I. Abraham a mourner, for the death of
Sarah, ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxiv.i-p3">II. Abraham a purchaser of a burying place
for Sarah. (1.) The purchase proposed by Abraham, ver. 3, 4. (2.)
Treated of and agreed, ver. 5-16. (3.) The purchase-money paid, ver. 16.
(4.) The premises conveyed and secured to Abraham, ver. 17, 18, 20. (5.)
Sarah's funeral, ver. 19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 23" progress="34.92%" prev="ii.ii.xxiv.i" next="ii.ii.xxv" id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p1">2. Abraham came to mourn for Sarah and to weep - He did
not only perform the ceremonies of mourning according to the custom of
those times, but did sincerely lament the great loss he had, and gave
proof of the constancy of his affection. Therefore these two words are
used, he came both to mourn and to weep.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p2">4. I am a stranger and a sojourner with you - Therefore I
am unprovided, and must become a suiter to you for a burying-place. This
was one occasion which Abraham took to confess that he was a stranger
and a pilgrim upon earth. The death of our relations should effectually
mind us that we are not at home in this world. That I may bury my dead
out of my sight - Death will make those unpleasant to our sight, who
while they lived were the desire of our eyes. The countenance that was
fresh and lively becomes pale and ghastly, and fit to be removed into
the land of darkness.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p3">6. Thou art a prince of God among us - So the word is;
not only great, but good. He called himself a stranger and a sojourner,
they call him a great prince.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p4">7. Abraham returns them thanks for their kind offer, with
all possible decency and respect. Religion teaches good manners, and
those abuse it that place it in rudeness and clownishness.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p5">11. The field give I thee - Abraham thought he must be
intreated to sell it, but upon the first mention, without intreaty, he
freely gives it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p6">13. I will give thee money for the field - It was not in
pride that Abraham refused the gift; but</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p7">1. In justice. Abraham was rich in silver
and gold, and therefore would not take advantage of Ephron's
generosity.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p8">2. In prudence. He would pay for it, lest
Ephron, when this good humour was over, should upbraid him with it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p9">15. The land is worth four hundred shekels of silver -
About fifty pounds of our money, but what is that between me and thee? -
He would rather oblige his friend than have so much money.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p10">20. A burying place - 'Tis worth noting,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p11">1. That a burying-place was the first spot
of ground Abraham was possessed of in Canaan.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxiv.ii-p12">2. That it was the only piece of land he
was ever possessed of, tho' it was all his own in reversion. Those that
have least of this earth find a grave in it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="34.95%" prev="ii.ii.xxiv.ii" next="ii.ii.xxv.i" id="ii.ii.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXIV" id="ii.ii.xxv-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 24" progress="34.96%" prev="ii.ii.xxv" next="ii.ii.xxv.ii" id="ii.ii.xxv.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.i-p1">The subjoining of Isaac's marriage to Sarah's funeral
(with a particular reference to it, ver. 67.) shews us, that as one
generation passeth away, another generation comes; and thus the entail
of human nature is preserved. Here is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxv.i-p2">I. Abraham's care about the marrying of his
son, and the charge he gave to his servant about it, ver. 1-9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxv.i-p3">II. The servant's journey into Abraham's
country to seek a wife for his young master among his own relations,
ver. 10-14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxv.i-p4">III. The kind providence which brought him
acquainted with Rebekah, whose father was Isaac's cousin german, ver.
15-28.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxv.i-p5">IV. The treaty of marriage with her
relations, ver. 29-49.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxv.i-p6">V. Their consent obtained, ver. 50-60.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxv.i-p7">VI. The happy meeting and marriage between
Isaac and Rebekah, ver. 61-67.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 24" progress="34.97%" prev="ii.ii.xxv.i" next="ii.ii.xxvi" id="ii.ii.xxv.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p1">1. Abraham's pious care concerning his son was, that he
should not marry with a daughter of Canaan, but with one of his kindred
because he saw, the Canaanites were degenerating into great wickedness,
and knew, that they were designed for ruin: would not marry his son
among them, lest they should be either a snare to his soul, or, at
least, a blot to his name. Yet he would not go himself among his
kindred, lest he should be tempted to settle there: this caution is
given, ver. 6, and repeated, ver. 8. Parents, in disposing of their
children, should carefully consult their furtherance in the way to
heaven.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p2">2. His eldest servant - Probably Eliezer of Damascus, one
whose conduct and affection he had had long experience of: he trusted
him with this great affair, and not Isaac himself, because he would not
have Isaac go at all into that country, but marry thither by proxy; and
no proxy so fit as the steward of his house. This matter is settled
between the master and the servant with a great deal of care and
solemnity. The servant is bound by an oath to do his utmost to get a
wife for Isaac among his relations, ver. 3, 4. Abraham swears him to it,
both for his own satisfaction, and for the engagement of his servant to
all possible care and diligence. Thus God swears his servants to their
work, that, having sworn, they may perform it. Swearing being an
ordinance, not peculiar to the church, but common to mankind, is to be
performed by such signs as are the common usages of our country.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p3">7. God's angels are ministering spirits, sent forth, not
only for the protection, but guidance of the heirs of promise, <scripRef passage="Heb. i. 14" id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Heb|1|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.1.14">Heb. i, 14</scripRef>. He shall send his angel before thee - And then thou shalt
speed well.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p4">11. He made his camels kneel down - Perhaps to unload
them.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p5">12. Send me good speed this day - We have leave to be
particular in recommending our affairs to the care of Divine providence.
Those that would have good speed must pray for it this day, in this
affair. Thus we must, in all our ways acknowledge God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p6">14. Let it come to pass - He prays God, that he would
please to make his way plain and clear before him, by the concurrence of
minute circumstances in his favour. It is the comfort, as well as the
belief, of a good man, that God's providence extends itself to the
smallest occurrences, and admirably serves its own purposes by them. And
it is our wisdom, in all our affairs, to follow providence. Yea, it is
very desirable, and that which we may lawfully pray for, while, in the
general, we set God's will before us as our rule, that he will, by hints
of providence, direct us in the way of our duty, and give us indications
what his mind is. Thus he guides his people with his eye, and leads them
in a plain path.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p7">15. And before he had done speaking, behold Rebekah came
out - Who in all respects, answered the characters he wished for in the
woman that was to be his master's wife, handsome and healthful, humble
and industrious, courteous and obliging to a stranger. And providence so
ordered it, that she did that which exactly answered his sign. She not
only gave him drink, but, which was more than could have been expected,
she offered her service to give his camels drink, which was the very
sign he proposed. God, in his providence, doth sometimes wonderfully own
the prayer of faith, and gratify the innocent desires of his praying
people even in little things, that he may shew the extent of his care,
and may encourage them at all times, to seek him, and trust in him; yet
we must take heed of being over bold in prescribing to God, lest the
event should weaken our faith rather than strengthen it. And the
concurrence of providences, and their minute circumstances, for the
furtherance of our success in any business, ought to be particularly
observed with wonder and thankfulness to the glory of God. We have been
wanting to ourselves both in duty and comfort, by neglecting to observe
providence.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p8">27. Blessed be the Lord God of my master Abraham -
Observe here,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p9">1. He had prayed for good speed, and now he
had sped well, he gives thanks.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p10">2. As yet, he was not certain what the
issue might prove, yet he gives thanks. When God's favours are coming
towards us; we must meet them with our praises. The Lord led me to the
house of my master's brethren -- those of them that were come out of Ur
of the Chaldees, though they were not come to Canaan, but staid in
Haran. They were not idolaters, but worshippers of the true God, and
inclinable to the religion of Abraham's family.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p11">29. We have here the making up of the marriage between
Isaac and Rebekah, related largely and particularly. Thus we are
directed to take notice of God's providence in the little common
occurrences of human life, and in them also to exercise our own
prudence, and other graces: for the scripture was not intended only for
the use of philosophers and statesmen, but to make us all wise and
virtuous in the conduct of ourselves and families.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p12">31. Come in thou blessed of the Lord - Perhaps, because
they heard from Rebekah, of the gracious words which proceeded out of
his mouth, they concluded him a good man, and therefore blessed of the
Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p13">34. I am Abraham' servant - Abraham's name, no doubt, was
well known among them, and respected; and we may suppose them not
altogether ignorant of his state, for Abraham knew theirs, chap. xxii,
20.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p14">45. Before I had done speaking in my heart - Which
perhaps he mentions, lest it should be suspected that Rebekah had
overheard his prayer, and designedly humoured it; no, saith he, I spake
it in my heart, so that none heard it but God, to whom thoughts are
words, and from him the answer came.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p15">50. The thing proceedeth from the Lord - Providence
smiles upon it, and we have nothing to say against it. A marriage is
then likely to be comfortable when it appears to proceed from the
Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p16">52. He worshipped the Lord - As his good success went on,
he went on to bless God: those that pray without ceasing should in every
thing give thanks, and own God in every step of mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p17">55. Let her abide a few days, at least ten - They had
consented to the marriage, and yet were loth to part with her. It is an
instance of the vanity of this world, that there is nothing in it so
agreeable but has its allay. They were pleased that they had matched a
daughter of their family so well, and yet it was with reluctancy that
they sent her away.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p18">57. Call the damsel, and inquire at her mouth - As
children ought not to marry without their parents consent, so parents
ought not to marry them without their own. Before the matter is resolved
on, ask at the damsel's mouth, she is a party principally concerned; and
therefore ought to be principally consulted.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p19">61. And her damsels - It seems then, when she went to the
well for water, it was not because she had no servants at command, but
because she took pleasure in the instances of humanity and industry.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p20">63. He went out to meditate (or pray) in the field at the
even tide - Some think he expected his servants about this time, and
went out on purpose to meet them. But it should seem he went out to take
the advantage of a silent evening, and a solitary field, for mediation
and prayer. Our walks in the field are then truly pleasant, when in them
we apply ourselves to meditation and prayer, we there have a free and
open prospect of the heavens above us, and the earth around us, and the
hosts and riches of both, by the view of which we should be led to the
contemplation of the Maker and Owner of all. Merciful providences are
then doubly comfortable, when they find us in the way of our duty: some
think Isaac was now praying for good success in this affair, and
meditating upon that which was proper to encourage his hope in God
concerning it; and now when he sets himself, as it were, upon his
watch-tower, to see what God would answer him, he sees the camels
coming.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxv.ii-p21">64. She lighted off her camel, and took a vail and
covered herself - In token of humility, modesty and subjection.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="35.11%" prev="ii.ii.xxv.ii" next="ii.ii.xxvi.i" id="ii.ii.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXV" id="ii.ii.xxvi-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.25" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxvi-p0.2">XXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 25" progress="35.11%" prev="ii.ii.xxvi" next="ii.ii.xxvi.ii" id="ii.ii.xxvi.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.i-p1">The sacred historian in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxvi.i-p2">I. Takes his leave of Abraham with an
account, (1.) Of his children by another wife, ver. 1-4. (2.) Of his
last will and testament, ver. 5, 6. (3.) Of his age, death and burial,
ver. 7, 8, 9, 10.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxvi.i-p3">II. He takes his leave of Ishmael, with a
short account, (1.) Of his children, ver. 12-16. (2.) Of his age and
death, ver. 17, 18.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxvi.i-p4">III. He enters upon the history of Isaac;
(1.) His posterity, ver. 11. (2.) The conception and birth of his two
sons, with the oracle of God concerning them, ver. 19-26. (3.) Their
different characters, ver. 27, 28. (4.) Esau's selling his birth-right
to Jacob, ver. 29-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 25" progress="35.12%" prev="ii.ii.xxvi.i" next="ii.ii.xxvii" id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p1">1. Five and thirty years Abraham lived after the marriage
of Isaac, and all that is recorded concerning him during that time lies
here in a very few verses: we hear no more of God's extraordinary
appearances to him, or trials of him; for all the days even of the
greatest saints are not eminent days, some slide on silently, and
neither come nor go with observation: such were these last days of
Abraham. We have here an account of his children by Keturah, another
wife, which he married after the death of Sarah. He had buried Sarah,
and married Isaac, the two dear companions of his life, and was now
solitary; his family wanted a governess and it was not good for him to
be thus alone; he therefore marries Keturah, probably the chief of his
maid servants, born in his house, or bought with money. By her he had
six sons, in whom the promise made to Abraham concerning the great
increase of his posterity was in part fulfilled. The strength he
received by the promise still remained in him, to shew how much the
virtue of the promise exceeds the power of nature.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p2">5. And Abraham gave all that he had to Isaac - As he was
bound to do in justice to Sarah his first wife, and to Rebekah who
married Isaac upon the assurance of it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p3">6. He gave gifts - Or portions to the rest of his
children, both to Ishmael, though at first he was sent empty away, and
to his sons by Keturah. It was justice to provide for them; parents that
do not that, are worse than infidels. It was prudence to settle them in
places distant from Isaac, that they might not pretend to divide the
inheritance with him. He did this while he yet lived, lest it should not
have been done, or not so well done afterwards. In many cases it is
wisdom for men to make their own hands their executors, and what they
find to do, to do it while they live. These sons of the concubines were
sent into the country that lay east from Canaan, and their posterity
were called the children of the east, famous for their numbers. Their
great increase was the fruit of the promise made to Abraham, that God
would multiply his seed.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p4">7. And these are the days of Abraham -- he lived one
hundred and seventy-five years; just a hundred years after he came to
Canaan; so long he was a sojourner in a strange country.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p5">8. He died in a good old age, an old man - So God had
promised him. His death was his discharge from the burdens of his age:
it was also the crown of the glory of his old age. He was full of years
- A good man, though he should not die old, dies full of days, satisfied
with living here, and longing to live in a better place. And was
gathered to his people - His body was gathered to the congregation of
the dead, and his soul to the congregation of the blessed. Death gathers
us to our people. Those that are our people while we live, whether the
people of God, or the children of this world, to them death will gather
us.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p6">9. Here is nothing recorded of the pomp or ceremony of
his funeral; only we are told, his sons Isaac and Ishmael buried him -
It was the last office of respect they had to pay to their good father.
Some distance there had formerly been between Isaac and Ishmael, but it
seems either Abraham had himself brought them together while he lived,
or at least his death reconciled them. They buried him, in his own
burying-place which he had purchased and in which he had buried Sarah.
Those that in life have been very dear to each other, may not only
innocently, but laudably, desire to be buried together, that, in their
deaths, they may not be divided, and in token of their hopes of rising
together.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p7">11. And God blessed Isaac - The blessing of Abraham did
not die with him, but survived to all the children of the promise. But
Moses presently digresseth from the story of Isaac, to give a short
account of Ishmael, for as much as he also was a son of Abraham; and God
had made some promises concerning him, which it was requisite we should
know the accomplishment of. He had twelve sons, twelve princes they are
called, ver. 16, heads of families, which, in process of time, became
nations, numerous and very considerable. They peopled a very large
continent that lay between Egypt and Assyria, called Arabia. The names
of his twelve sons are recorded: Midian and Kedar we oft read of in
scripture. And his posterity had not only tents in the fields wherein
they grew rich in times of peace, but they had towns and castles, ver.
16, where in they fortified themselves in time of war. Their number and
strength was the fruit of the promise made to Hagar concerning Ishmael,
chap. xvi, 10. and to Abraham, chap. xvii, 20; xxi, 13.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p8">17. He lived an hundred and thirty and seven years -
Which is recorded to shew the efficacy of Abraham's prayer for him,
chap. xvii, 18. O that Ishmael might live before thee! Then he also was
gathered to his people. And he died in the presence of all his brethren
- With his friends about him. Who would not wish so to do?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p9">20. And Isaac was forty years old - Not much is related
concerning Isaac, but what had reference to his father, while he lived,
and to his sons afterward; for Isaac seems not to have been a man of
action, nor much tried, but to have spent his day, in quietness and
silence.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p10">21. And Isaac intreated the Lord for his wife - Though
God had promised to multiply his family, he prayed for it; for God's
promises must not supersede but encourage our prayers, and be improved
as the ground of our faith. Though he had prayed for this mercy many
years, and it was not granted, yet he did not leave off praying for
it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p11">22. The children struggled within her - The commotion was
altogether extra-ordinary, and made her very uneasy: If it be so, or,
since it is so, why am I thus? - Before the want of children was her
trouble, now the struggle of the children is no less so. And she went to
inquire of the Lord - Some think Melchizedek was now consulted as an
oracle, or perhaps some Urim or Teraphim were now used to inquire of God
by, as afterwards in the breast-plate of judgment. The word and prayer,
by which we now inquire of the Lord, give great relief to those that are
upon any account perplexed: it is a mighty ease to spread our case
before the Lord, and ask council at his mouth.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p12">23. Two nations are in thy womb - She was now big not
only with two children, but two nations, which should not only in their
manners greatly differ from each other, but in their interest contend
with each other, and the issue of the contest should be that the elder
should serve the younger, which was fulfilled in the subjection of the
Edomites for many ages to the house of David.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p13">25. Esau when he was born was red and hairy, as if he had
been already a grown man, whence he had his name Esau, made, reared
already. This was an indication of a very strong constitution, and gave
cause to expect that he would be a very robust, daring, active man. But
Jacob was smooth and tender as other children.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p14">26. His hand took hold on Esau's heel - This
signified,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p15">1. Jacob's pursuit of the birth-right and
blessing; from the first he reached forth to have catched hold of it,
and if possible to have prevented his brother.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p16">2. His prevailing for it at last: that in
process of time he should gain his point. This passage is referred to <scripRef passage="Hosea xii. 3" id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Hos|12|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.12.3">Hosea xii, 3</scripRef>, and from hence he had his name Jacob, a supplanter.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p17">27. Esau was an hunter - And a man that knew how to live
by his wits, for he was a cunning hunter. A man of the field - All for
the game, and never so well but as when he was in pursuit of it. And
Jacob was a plain man - An honest man, that dealt fairly. And dwelt in
tents - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p18">1. As a shepherd, loving that safe and
silent employment of keeping sheep, to which also he bred up his
children, chap. xlvi, 34. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p19">2. As a student, he frequented the tents of
Melchizedek or Heber, as some understand it, to be taught by them divine
things.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p20">28. And Isaac loved Esau - Isaac though he was not a
stirring man himself, yet he loved to have his son active. Esau knew how
to please him, and shewed a great respect for him, by treating him often
with venison, which won upon him more than one would have thought. But
Rebekah loved him whom God loved.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p21">29. Sod - That is, boiled.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p22">30. Edom - That is, red.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p23">31. Sell me this day thy birth-right - He cannot be
excused in taking advantage of Esau's necessity, yet neither can Esau be
excused who is profane, <scripRef passage="Heb. xii. 16" id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p23.1" parsed="|Heb|12|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.12.16">Heb. xii,
16</scripRef>, because for one morsel of meat he sold his birth-right. The
birth-right was typical of spiritual privileges, those of the church of
the first-born: Esau was now tried how he would value those, and he
shews himself sensible only of present grievances: may he but get relief
against them, he cares not for his birth-right. If we look on Esau's
birth-right as only a temporal advantage, what he said had something of
truth in it, that our worldly enjoyments, even those we are most fond
of, will stand us in no stead in a dying hour. They will not put by the
stroke of death, nor ease the pangs, nor remove the sting. But being of
a spiritual nature, his undervaluing it, was the greatest profaneness
imaginable. It is egregious folly to part with our interest in God, and
Christ, and heaven, for the riches, honours, and pleasures of this
world.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvi.ii-p24">34. He did eat and drink, and rise up and went his way -
Without any serious reflections upon the ill bargain he had made, or any
shew of regret. Thus Esau despised his birth-right - He used no means to
get the bargain revoked, made no appeal to his father about it but the
bargain which his necessity had made, (supposing it were so) his
profaneness confirmed, and by his subsequent neglect and contempt, he
put the bargain past recall.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="35.29%" prev="ii.ii.xxvi.ii" next="ii.ii.xxvii.i" id="ii.ii.xxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXVI" id="ii.ii.xxvii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.26" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxvii-p0.2">XXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 26" progress="35.29%" prev="ii.ii.xxvii" next="ii.ii.xxvii.ii" id="ii.ii.xxvii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.i-p1">In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxvii.i-p2">I. Isaac in adversity, by reason of a
famine in the land; which, (1.) Obliges him to change his quarters, ver
1. but, (2.) God visits him with direction and comfort, ver. 2-5. (3.)
He denies his wife, and is reproved for it by Abimelech, ver. 6-11.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxvii.i-p3">II. Isaac in prosperity, by the blessing of
God upon him, ver. 12- 14. (1.) The Philistines were envious at him,
ver. 14-17. (2.) He continued industrious in his business, ver. 18-23.
(3.) God appeared to him, and encouraged him, and he returned to his
duty, ver. 24-25. (4.) The Philistines at length made court to him, and
made a covenant with him, ver. 26-33</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxvii.i-p4">III. The disagreeable marriage of his son
Esau was an allay to his prosperity, ver. 34. 35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 26" progress="35.30%" prev="ii.ii.xxvii.i" next="ii.ii.xxviii" id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p1">2. The Lord said, go not down into Egypt. Sojourn in this
land - There was a famine in Jacob's days, and God bid him go down into
Egypt, chap. xlvi, 3, 4, a famine in Isaac's days, and God bid him not
go down: a famine in Abraham's days, and God left him to his liberty,
directing him neither way, which (considering that Egypt was always a
place of trial to God's people) some ground upon the different
characters of these three patriarchs. Abraham was a man of very intimate
communion with God, and to him all places and conditions were alike;
Isaac a very good man, but not cut out for hardship, therefore he is
forbidden to go to Egypt; Jacob inured to difficulties, strong and
patient, and therefore he must go down into Egypt, that the trial of his
faith might be to praise, and honour, and glory. Thus God proportions
his people's trials to their strength.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p2">5. Abraham obeyed my voice - Do thou do so too, and the
promise shall be sure to thee. A great variety of words is here used to
express the Divine Will to which Abraham was obedient, my voice, my
charge, my commandments, my statutes, and my laws - Which may intimate,
that Abraham's obedience was universal; he obeyed the original laws of
nature, the revealed laws of divine worship, particularly that of
circumcision, and all the extraordinary precepts God gave him, as that
of quitting his country, and that (which some think is more especially
referred to) the offering up of his son, which Isaac himself had reason
enough to remember. Those only shall have the benefit of God's covenant
with their parents, that tread the steps of their obedience.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p3">7. He said, she is my sister - So Isaac enters into the
same temptation that his father had been once and again surprised and
overcome by, viz. to deny his wife, and to give out that she was his
sister! It is an unaccountable thing, that both these great and good men
should be guilty of so odd a piece of dissimulation, by which they so
much exposed both their own and their wives reputation.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p4">8. This Abimelech was not the same that was in Abraham's
days, chap. xx, 2-18, for this was near an hundred years after, but that
was the common name of the Philistine kings, as Caesar of the Roman
emperors.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p5">10. Lightly - Perhaps.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p6">12. Isaac received an hundred fold - And there seems to
be an emphasis laid upon the time; it was that same year when there was
a famine in the land; while others scarce reaped at all, he reaped thus
plentifully.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p7">20. Esek - That is, contention.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p8">21. Sitnah - That is, hatred.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p9">22. He digged a well, and for that they strove not -
Those that follow peace, sooner or later, shall find peace: those that
study to be quiet seldom fail of being so. This well they called
Rehoboth - Enlargements, room enough.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p10">24. Fear not, I am with thee, and will bless thee - Those
may remove with comfort that are sure of God's presence with them
wherever they go.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p11">28. The Lord is with thee, and thou art the blessed of
the Lord, q.d. Be persuaded to overlook the injuries offered thee, for
God has abundantly made up to thee the damage thou receivedst. Those
whom God blesseth and favours, have reason enough to forgive those that
hate them, since the worst enemy they have cannot do them any real hurt.
Let there be an oath betwixt us - Whatever some of his envious subjects
might mean, he and his prime ministers, whom he had now brought with
him, designed no other but a cordial friendship. Perhaps Abimelech had
received by tradition the warning God gave to his predecessor not to
hurt Abraham, chap. xx, 7, and that made him stand in such awe of Isaac,
who appeared to be as much the favourite of heaven as Abraham was.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxvii.ii-p12">34. He took to wife - Marrying Canaanites, who were
strangers to the blessing of Abraham, and subject to the curse of
Noah.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="35.37%" prev="ii.ii.xxvii.ii" next="ii.ii.xxviii.i" id="ii.ii.xxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXVII" id="ii.ii.xxviii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.27" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxviii-p0.2">XXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 27" progress="35.37%" prev="ii.ii.xxviii" next="ii.ii.xxviii.ii" id="ii.ii.xxviii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.i-p1">We have here,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxviii.i-p2">I. Isaac's purpose to entail the blessing
upon Esau, ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxviii.i-p3">II. Rebekah's plot to procure it for Jacob,
ver. 6-17.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxviii.i-p4">III. Jacob's obtaining of the blessing,
ver. 18-29.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxviii.i-p5">IV. Esau's resentment of this. In which,
(1.) His importunity with his father to obtain a blessing, ver. 30- 40.
(2.) His enmity to his brother for defrauding him, ver. 41-46.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 27" progress="35.38%" prev="ii.ii.xxviii.i" next="ii.ii.xxix" id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p1">1. Here is Isaac's design to declare Esau his heir. The
promise of the Messiah and the land of Canaan was a great trust first
committed to Abraham, inclusive and typical of spiritual and eternal
blessings; this by divine direction he transmitted to Isaac. Isaac being
now old, and either not knowing, or not duly considering the divine
oracle concerning his two sons, that the elder should serve the younger,
resolves to entail all the honour and power that was wrapt up in the
promise upon Esau, his eldest son. He called Esau - Tho' Esau, had
greatly grieved his parents by his marriage, yet they had not expelled
him, but it seems were pretty well reconciled to him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p2">2. I am old, and know not the day of my death - How soon
I may die.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p3">3. Take me some venison that I may; bless thee - Esau
must go a hunting and bring some venison. In this he designed not so
much the refreshment of his own spirits, as the receiving a fresh
instance of his son's, filial duty and affection to him, before he
bestowed this favour upon him. That my soul may bless thee before I die
- Prayer is the work of the soul, and not of the lips only; as the soul
must be employed in blessing God, <scripRef passage="Psalm ciii. 1" id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Ps|103|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.103.1">Psalm ciii, 1</scripRef>, so it must be in blessing ourselves and others: the
blessing will not go to the heart, if it do not come from the heart.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p4">6. Rebekah is here contriving to procure the blessing for
Jacob, which was designed for Esau. If the end was good, the means were
bad, and no way justifiable. If it were not a wrong to Esau to deprive
him of the blessing, he himself having forfeited it by selling the birth
right, yet it was a wrong to Isaac, taking advantage of his infirmity,
to impose upon him: it was a wrong to Jacob, whom she taught to deceive,
by putting a lie in his mouth. If Rebekah, when she heard Isaac promise
the blessing to Esau, had gone to him, and with humility and seriousness
put him in remembrance of that which God had said concerning their sons;
if she had farther shewed him how Esau had forfeited the blessing, both
by selling his birth-right, and by marrying of strange wives; 'tis
probable Isaac would have been prevailed with to confer the blessing
upon Jacob, and needed not thus to have been cheated into it. This had
been honourable and laudable, and would have looked well in history; but
God left her to herself to take this indirect course, that he might have
the glory of bringing good out of evil.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p5">19. And Jacob said, I am Esau - Who would have thought
this plain man could have played such a part? His mother having put him
in the way of it, he applies himself to those methods which he had never
accustomed himself to, but had always conceived an abhorrence of. But
lying is soon learned. I wonder how honest Jacob could so readily turn
his tongue to say, I am Esau thy first-born: and when his father asked
him, ver. 24. Art thou my very son Esau? to reply I am. How could he
say, I have done as thou badst me, when he had received no command from
his father, but was doing as his mother bid him? How could he say, Eat
of my venison, when he knew it came not from the field, but from the
fold? But especially I wonder how he could have the forehead to father
it upon God, and to use his name in the cheat.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p6">20. The Lord thy God brought it to me - Is this Jacob? It
is certainly written not for our imitation, but our admonition, Let him
that, standeth, take heed lest he fall. Now let us see how Isaac gave
Jacob his blessing. 27-1. He kissed him; in token of particular
affection to him. Those that are blessed of God are kissed with the
kisses of his mouth, and they do by love and loyalty kiss the son, <scripRef passage="Psalm ii. 12" id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Ps|2|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.2.12">Psalm ii, 12</scripRef>. 2. He praised him. Upon occasion of the sweet smell of his
garments he said, See the smell of my son is as the smell of a field
which the Lord hath blessed - That is, like that of the most fragrant
flowers and spices. Three things Jacob is here blessed with, (1.)
Plenty, ver. 28. Heaven and earth concurring to make him rich. (2.)
Power, ver. 29. Particularly dominion over his brethren, viz. Esau and
his posterity. (3.) Prevalency with God, and a great interest in heaven,
Cursed be every one that curseth thee - Let God be a friend to all thy
friends, and an enemy to all thine enemies. Now, certainly more is
comprised in this blessing than appears at first; it must amount to an
entail of the promise of the Messiah: that was in the patriarchal
dialect the blessing; something spiritual doubtless is included in it.
First, That from him should come the Messiah, that should have a
sovereign dominion on earth. See <scripRef passage="Num. xxiv. 19" id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Num|24|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.24.19">Num. xxiv, 19</scripRef>. Out of Jacob shall come he that shall have dominion, the
star and scepter, <scripRef passage="Num. xxiv. 17" id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p6.3" parsed="|Num|24|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.24.17">Num. xxiv, 17</scripRef>. Jacob's dominion over Esau was to be only typical of this,
chap. xlix, 10. Secondly, That from him should come the church that
should be particularly owned and favoured by Heaven. It was part of the
blessing of Abraham when he was first called to be the father of the
faithful, chap. xii, 3. I will bless them that bless thee; therefore
when Isaac afterwards confirmed the blessing to Jacob, he called it the
blessing of Abraham, chap. xxviii, 4.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p7">33. Isaac trembled exceedingly - Those that follow the
choice of their own affections rather than the dictates of the Divine
will, involve themselves in such perplexities as these. But he soon
recovers himself, and ratifies the blessing he had given to Jacob, I
have blessed him, and he shall be blessed - He might have recalled it,
but now at last he is sensible he was in an error when he designed it
for Esau. Either recollecting the Divine oracle, or having found himself
more than ordinarily filled with the Holy Ghost when he gave the
blessing to Jacob, he perceived that God did as it were say Amen to
it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p8">39. Esau likewise obtained a blessing: yet it was far
short of Jacob's.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p9">1. In Jacob's blessing the dew of heaven is
put first, as that which he most valued and desired: in Esau's the
fatness of the earth is put first, for that was it which he had the
principal regard to.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p10">2. Esau hath these, but Jacob hath them
from God's hand. God give thee the dew of heaven, ver. 28. It was enough
to have the possession, but Jacob desired it by promise.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p11">3. Jacob shall have dominion over his
brethren, for the Israelites often ruled over the Edomites. Esau shall
have dominion, he shall gain some power, but shall never have dominion
over his brother: we never find that the Jews were sold into the hands
of the Edomites, or that they oppressed them. But the great difference
is, that there is nothing in Esau's blessing that points at Christ,
nothing that brings either him or his into the church, and without that
the fatness of the earth, and the plunder of the field, will stand him
in little stead. Thus Isaac by faith blessed them both, according as
their lot should be.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p12">45. Why should I be deprived of you both? - Not only of
the murdered, but of the murderer, who either by the magistrate, or by
the immediate hand of God would be sacrificed to justice.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxviii.ii-p13">46. If Jacob take a wife of the daughters of Heth - As
Esau has done. More artifice still. This was not the thing she was
afraid of. But if we use guile once, we shall be very ready to use it
again. It should be carefully observed, That altho' a blessing came on
his posterity by Jacob's vile lying and dissimulation, yet it brought
heavy affliction upon himself, and that for a long term of years. So
severely did God punish him personally, for doing evil that good might
come.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVIII" progress="35.51%" prev="ii.ii.xxviii.ii" next="ii.ii.xxix.i" id="ii.ii.xxix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXVIII" id="ii.ii.xxix-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|28|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.28" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxix-p0.2">XXVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 28" progress="35.51%" prev="ii.ii.xxix" next="ii.ii.xxix.ii" id="ii.ii.xxix.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.i-p1">We have here,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxix.i-p2">I. Jacob's parting with his parents to go
to Padan-aram: the charge his father gave him, ver. 1, 2. the blessing
he sent him away with, ver. 3, 4. his obedience to the orders given him,
ver. 5-10. and the influence this had upon Esau, ver. 6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxix.i-p3">II. Jacob's meeting with God, and his
communion with him by the way. And there, (1.) His vision of the ladder,
ver. 11, 12. (2.) The gracious promise God made him, ver. 13, 14, 15.
(3.) The impression this made upon him, ver. 16-19. (4.) The vow he made
to God upon this occasion, ver. 20, 21, 22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 28" progress="35.52%" prev="ii.ii.xxix.i" next="ii.ii.xxx" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p1">1. Isaac blessed him, and charged him - Those that have
the blessing must keep the charge annexed to it, and not think to
separate what God has joined.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p2">3, 4. Two great promises Abraham was blessed with, and
Isaac here entails them both upon Jacob. (1.) The promise of heirs, God
make thee fruitful and multiply thee.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p3">1. Through his loins that people should
descend from Abraham which should be numerous as the stars of
heaven.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p4">2. Through his loins should descend from
Abraham that person in whom all the families of the earth should be
blessed. (2.) The promise of an inheritance for those heirs, ver. 4.
That thou mayest inherit the land of thy sojournings - (So the Hebrew)
Canaan was hereby entailed upon the seed of Jacob, exclusive of the seed
of Esau. Isaac was now sending Jacob away into a distant country to
settle there for some time; and lest this should look like disinheriting
him, he here confirms the settlement of it upon him. This promise looks
as high as heaven, of which Canaan was a type. That was the better
country which Jacob, with the other patriarchs, had in his eye when he
confessed himself a stranger and pilgrim on the earth, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 16" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Heb|11|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.16">Heb. xi, 16</scripRef>. See note at "ver. 3"</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p5">5. Rebekah is here called Jacob's and Esau's mother -
Jacob is named first, not only because he had always been his mother's
darling, but because he was now made his father's heir, and Esau was
postponed.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p6">6. This passage comes in, in the midst of Jacob's story,
to shew the influence of a good example. Esau now begins to think Jacob
the better man, and disdains not to take him for his pattern in this
particular instance of marrying with a daughter of Abraham.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p7">11. The stones for his pillow, and the heavens for his
canopy! Yet his comfort in the divine blessing, and his confidence in
the divine protection, made him easy, even when he lay thus exposed:
being sure that his God made him to dwell in safety, he could lie down
and sleep upon a stone.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p8">12. Behold a ladder set upon the earth, and the top of it
reached heaven, the angels ascending and descending on it, and the Lord
stood above it - This might represent</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p9">1. The providence of God, by which there is
a constant correspondence kept up between heaven and earth. The counsels
of heaven are executed on earth, and the affairs of this earth are all
known in heaven. Providence doth his work gradually and by steps; angels
are employed as ministering spirits to serve all the designs of
providence, and the wisdom of God is at the upper end of the ladder,
directing all the motions of second causes to his glory. The angels are
active spirits, continually ascending and descending; they rest not day
nor night. They ascend to give account of what they have done, and to
receive orders; and desend to execute the orders they have received.
This vision gave seasonable comfort to Jacob, letting him know that he
had both a good guide and good guard; that though he was to wander from
his father's house, yet he was the care of Providence, and the charge of
the holy angels.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p10">2. The mediation of Christ. He is this
ladder: the foot on earth in his human nature, the top in heaven in his
divine nature; or the former is his humiliation, the latter is his
exaltation. All the intercourse between heaven and earth since the fall
is by this ladder. Christ is the way: all God's favours come to us, and
all our services come to him, by Christ. If God dwell with us, and we
with him, it is by Christ: we have no way of getting to heaven but by
this ladder; for the kind offices the angels do us, are all owing to
Christ, who hath reconciled things on earth and things in heaven, <scripRef passage="Colossians i. 20" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Col|1|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.1.20">Colossians i, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p11">14. In thy seed shall all the families of the earth be
blessed - Christ is the great blessing of the world: all that are
blessed, whatever family they are of, are blessed in him, and none of
any family are excluded from blessedness in him, but those that exclude
themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p12">15. Behold I am with thee - Wherever we are, we are safe,
if we have God's favourable presence with us. He knew not, but God
foresaw what hardships he would meet with in his uncle's service, and
therefore promiseth to preserve him in all places. God knows how to give
his people graces and comforts accommodated to the events that shall be,
as well as to those that are. He was now going as an exile into a place
far distant, but God promiseth him to bring him again to this land. He
seemed to be forsaken of all his friends, but God gives him this
assurance, I will not leave thee.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p13">16. Surely the Lord is in this place, and I knew it not -
God's manifestations of himself to his people carry their own evidence
along with them. God can give undeniable demonstrations of his presence,
such as give abundant satisfaction to the souls of the faithful, that
God is with them of a truth; satisfaction not communicable to others,
but convincing to themselves. We sometimes meet with God there, where we
little thought of meeting with him. He is there where we did not think
he had been, is found there where we asked not for him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p14">17. He was afraid - So far was he from being puffed up.
The more we see of God, the more cause we see for holy trembling and
blushing before him. Those whom God is pleased to manifest himself to,
are laid and kept very low in their own eyes, and see cause to fear even
the Lord and his goodness, <scripRef passage="Hosea iii. 5" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Hos|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.3.5">Hosea iii,
5</scripRef>. And said, How dreadful is this place! - That is, the
appearance of God in this place is to be thought of, but with a holy awe
and reverence; I shall have a respect for this place, and remember it by
this token as long as I live. Not that he thought the place itself any
nearer the divine visions than any other places; but what he saw there
at this time was, as it were, the house of God, the residence of the
Divine Majesty, and the gate of heaven, that is, the general rendezvous
of the inhabitants of the upper world; as the meetings of a city were in
their gates; or, the angels ascending and descending were like travelers
passing and repassing through the gates of a city.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p15">18. He set up the stone for a pillar - To mark the place
again, if he came back, and erect a lasting monument of God's favour to
him: and because he had not time now to build an altar here, as Abraham
did in the places where God appeared to him, chap. xii, 7, he therefore
poured oil on the top of this stone, which probably was the ceremony
then used in dedicating their altars, as an earnest of his building an
altar when he should have conveniencies for it, as afterwards he did, in
gratitude to God, chap. xxxv, 7. Grants of mercy call for our returns of
duty and the sweet communion we have with God ought ever to be
remembered.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p16">19. It had been called Luz, an almond-tree, but he will
have it henceforth called Beth-el, the house of God. This gracious
appearance of God to him made it more remarkable than all the
almond-trees that flourished there.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p17">20. And Jacob vowed a vow - By religious vows we give
glory to God, and own our dependance upon him, and we lay a bond upon
our own souls, to engage and quicken our obedience to him. Jacob was now
in fear and distress, and in times of trouble it is seasonable to make
vows, or when we are in pursuit of any special mercy, <scripRef passage="John i. 16" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p17.1" parsed="|John|1|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.16">John i, 16</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Psalm lxvi. 13, 14" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p17.2" parsed="|Ps|66|13|66|14" osisRef="Bible:Ps.66.13-Ps.66.14">Psalm lxvi, 13, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="1 Sam. i. 11" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p17.3" parsed="|1Sam|1|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.1.11">1 Sam. i, 11</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Num. xxi. 1, 2, 3" id="ii.ii.xxix.ii-p17.4" parsed="|Num|21|1|21|3" osisRef="Bible:Num.21.1-Num.21.3">Num. xxi, 1, 2, 3</scripRef>. Jacob had now had a gracious visit from heaven, God had
renewed his covenant with him, and the covenant is mutual; when God
ratifies his promises to us, it is proper for us to repeat our promises
to him. If thou wilt be with me and keep me - We need desire no more to
make us easy and happy wherever we are, but to have God's presence with
us, and to be under his protection. It is comfortable in a journey to
have a guide in an unknown way, a guard in a dangerous way, to be well
carried, well provided for, and to have good company in any way; and
they that have God with them, have all this in the best manner. Then
shall the Lord be my God - Then I will rejoice in him as my God, then I
will be the more strongly engaged to abide with him. And this pillar
shall be God's house - That is, an altar shall be erected here to the
honour of God. And of all that thou shalt give me I will surely give the
tenth unto thee - To be spent either upon God's altar or upon his poor,
which are both his receivers in the world. The tenth is a very fit
proportion to be devoted to God, and employed for him; though as
circumstances vary, it may be more or less, as God prospers us.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIX" progress="35.67%" prev="ii.ii.xxix.ii" next="ii.ii.xxx.i" id="ii.ii.xxx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXIX" id="ii.ii.xxx-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|29|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.29" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxx-p0.2">XXIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 29" progress="35.67%" prev="ii.ii.xxx" next="ii.ii.xxx.ii" id="ii.ii.xxx.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.i-p1">This chapter gives us an account of God's providences
concerning Jacob, pursuant to the promise made him in the foregoing
chapter.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxx.i-p2">I. How he was brought in safety to his
journey's end, and directed to his relations there, who bid him welcome,
ver. 1-14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxx.i-p3">II. How he was comfortably disposed of in
marriage, ver. 15-30.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxx.i-p4">III. How his family was built up in the
birth of four sons, ver. 31- 35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 29" progress="35.68%" prev="ii.ii.xxx.i" next="ii.ii.xxxi" id="ii.ii.xxx.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p1">2. Providence brought him to the very field where his
uncle's flock's were to be watered, and there he met with Rachel that
was to be his wife. The Divine Providence is to be acknowledged in all
the little circumstances which concur to make a journey or other
undertaking comfortable and successful. If, when we are at a loss, we
meet with those seasonably that can direct us; if we meet with a
disaster, and those are at hand that will help us; we must not say it
was by chance, but it was by providence: our ways are ways of
pleasantness, if we continually acknowledge God in them. The stone on
the well's mouth was either to secure their property in it, for water
was scarce, to save the well from receiving damage from the heat of the
sun, or to prevent the lambs of the flock from being drowned in it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p2">9. She kept her father's sheep - She took the care of
them, having servants under her that were employed about them when he
understood that this was his kinswoman (probably he had heard of her
name before) knowing what his errand was into that country, we may
suppose it struck into his mind immediately, that this must be his wife,
as one already smitten with an honest comely face (though it is likely,
sun-burnt, and she in the homely dress of a shepherdess) he is
wonderfully officious, and ready to serve her, ver. 10, and addresses
himself to her with tears of joy, and kisses of love, ver. 11, she runs
with all haste to tell her father, for she will by no means entertain
her kinsman's address without her father's knowledge and approbation,
ver. 12. These mutual respects at their first interview were good
presages of their being a happy couple. Providence made that which
seemed contingent and fortuitous to give a speedy satisfaction to
Jacob's mind as soon as ever he came to the place he was bound for.
Abraham's servant, when he came upon a like errand, met with the like
encouragement. Thus God guides his people with his eye, <scripRef passage="Psalm xxxii. 8" id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Ps|32|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.32.8">Psalm xxxii, 8</scripRef>. It is a groundless conceit which some of the Jewish writers
have, that Jacob when he kissed Rachel wept, because he had been set
upon his journey by Eliphaz the eldest son of Esau, at the command of
his father, and robbed him of all his money and jewels, which his mother
had given him when she sent him away: it is plain it was his passion for
Rachel, and the surprise of this happy meeting that drew these tears
from his eyes. Laban, though none of the best humoured men, bid him
welcome, was satisfied in the account he gave of himself, and of the
reason of his coming in such poor circumstances. While we avoid the
extreme on the one hand of being foolishly credulous, we must take heed
of falling into the other extreme of being uncharitably jealous and
suspicious. Laban owned him for his kinsman, ver. 14. Thou art my bone
and my flesh. Note, Those are hard-hearted indeed that are unkind to
their relations, and that hide themselves from their own flesh, <scripRef passage="Isaiah lviii. 7" id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Isa|58|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.58.7">Isaiah lviii,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p3">15. Because thou art my brother - That is, kinsman.
Should thou therefore serve me for nought? - No, what reason for that?
If Jacob be so respectful as to give him his service without demanding
any consideration for it, yet Laban will not be so unjust as to take
advantage either of his necessity, or of his good nature. It appears by
computation that Jacob was now seventy years old when he bound himself
apprentice for a wife; probably Rachel was young and scarce marriageable
when Jacob came first, which made him the more willing to stay for her
till his seven years were expired.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p4">20. They seemed to him but a few days for the love he had
to her - An age of work will be but as a few days to those that love
God, and long for Christ's appearing.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p5">25. Behold it was Leah - Jacob had cheated his own father
when he pretended to be Esau, and now his father-in-law cheated him.
Herein, how unrighteous soever Laban was, the Lord was righteous.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p6">26. It must be so done in our country - We have reason to
think there was no such custom in his country; but if there was, and
that he resolved to observe it, he should have told Jacob so, when he
undertook to serve him for his younger daughter.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p7">27. We will give thee this also - Hereby he drew Jacob
into the sin and snare, and disquiet of multiplying wives. Jacob did not
design it, but to have kept as true to Rachel as his father had done to
Rebekah; he that had lived without a wife to the eighty fourth year of
his age could then have been very well content with one: but Laban to
dispose of his two daughters without portions, and to get seven years
service more out of Jacob, thus imposeth upon him, and draws him into
such a strait, that he had some colourable reason for marrying them
both.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p8">31. When the Lord saw that Leah was hated - That is,
loved less than Rachel, in which sense it is required that we hate
father and mother, in comparison with Christ, <scripRef passage="Luke xiv. 26" id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Luke|14|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.14.26">Luke xiv, 26</scripRef>, then the Lord granted her a child, which was a rebuke to
Jacob for making so great a difference between those he was equally
related to; a check to Rachel, who, perhaps insulted over her sister
upon that account; and a comfort to Leah, that she might not be
overwhelmed with the contempt put upon her.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxx.ii-p9">32. She appears very ambitious of her husband's love; she
reckoned the want of it her affliction, not upbraiding him with it as
his fault, nor reproaching him for it; but laying it to heart as her
grief, which she had reason to bear, because she was consenting to the
fraud by which she became his wife. She called her first-born Reuben,
see a son, with this pleasant thought, Now will my husband love me. And
her third son Levi, joined, with this expectation, Now will my husband
be joined unto me. The Lord hath heard, that is, taken notice of it,
that I was hated, he hath therefore given me this son. Her fourth she
called Judah, praise, saying, Now will I praise the Lord. And this was
he, of whom, as concerning the flesh Christ came. Whatever is the matter
of our rejoicing, ought to be the matter of our thanksgiving. And all
our praises must center in Christ, both as the matter of them, and as
the Mediator of them. He descended from him whose name was praise, for
he is our praise. Is Christ formed in my heart? Now will I praise the
Lord.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXX" progress="35.79%" prev="ii.ii.xxx.ii" next="ii.ii.xxxi.i" id="ii.ii.xxxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXX" id="ii.ii.xxxi-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|30|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.30" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxxi-p0.2">XXX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 30" progress="35.79%" prev="ii.ii.xxxi" next="ii.ii.xxxi.ii" id="ii.ii.xxxi.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.i-p1">In this chapter we have an account of the increase,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxi.i-p2">I. Of Jacob's family; eight children more
we find registered in this chapter; Daniel and Naphtali by Bilhah,
Rachel's maid, ver. 1-8. Gad and Asher by Zilpah, Leah's maid, ver.
9-13. Issachar, Zebulon, and Dinah, by Leah, ver. 14-21. And last of all
Joseph by Rachel, ver. 22-24.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxi.i-p3">II. Of Jacob's estate. He comes upon a new
bargain with Laban, ver. 25-34. And in the six years further service he
did to Laban, God wonderfully blessed him, so that his flock of all
cattle became very considerable, ver. 35-43, And herein was fulfilled
the blessing which Isaac dismissed him with, chap. xxviii. 3. God make
thee fruitful and multiply thee.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 30" progress="35.80%" prev="ii.ii.xxxi.i" next="ii.ii.xxxii" id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p1">1. Rachel envied her sister - Envy is grieving at the
good of another, than which no sin is more injurious both to God, our
neighbour, and ourselves. But this was not all, she said to Jacob, give
me children or else I die - A child would not content her; but because
Leah has more than one, she must have more too; Give me children: her
heart is set upon it. Give them me, else I die, That is, I shall fret
myself to death. The want of this satisfaction will shorten my days.
Observe a difference between Rachel's asking for this mercy, and
Hannah's, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. i. 10" id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|1Sam|1|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.1.10">1 Sam. i, 10</scripRef>, &amp;c. Rachel envied, Hannah wept: Rachel must have
children, and she died of the second; Hannah prayed for this child, and
she had four more: Rachel is importunate and peremptory, Hannah is
submissive and devout, If thou wilt give me a child, I will give him to
the Lord. Let Hannah be imitated, and not Rachel; and let our desires be
always under the conduct and check of reason and religion.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p2">2. And Jacob's anger was kindled - He was angry, not at
the person, but at the sin: he expressed himself so as to shew his
displeasure. It was a grave and pious reply which Jacob gave to Rachel,
Am I in God's stead? - Can I give thee that which God denies thee? He
acknowledges the hand of God in the affliction: He hath withheld the
fruit of the womb. Whatever we want, it is God that with-holds it, as
sovereign Lord, most wise, holy, and just, that may do what he will with
his own, and is debtor to no man: that never did, nor ever can do, any
wrong to any of his creatures. The key of the clouds, of the heart, of
the grave, and of the womb, are four keys which God has in his hand, and
which (the Rabbins say) he intrusts neither with angel nor seraphin. He
also acknowledges his own inability to alter what God appointed, Am I in
God's stead? What, dost thou make a God of me? There is no creature that
is, or can be, to us in God's stead. God may be to us, instead of any
creature, as the sun instead of the moon and stars; but the moon and all
the stars will not be to us instead of the sun. No creature's wisdom,
power, and love will be to us instead of God's. It is therefore our sin
and folly to place that confidence in any creature, which is to be
placed in God only.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p3">3. Behold my maid, Bilhah - At the persuasion of Rachel
he took Bilhah her handmaid to wife, that, according to the usage of
those times, his children by her might be adopted and owned as her
mistresses children. She would rather have children by reputation than
none at all; children that she might call her own, though they were not
so. And as an early instance of her dominion over the children born in
her apartment, she takes a pleasure in giving them names, that carry in
them nothing but marks of emulation with her sister. As if she had
overcome her,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p4">1. At law, she calls the flrst son of her
handmaid, Daniel, Judgment, saying, God hath Judged me - That is, given
sentence in my favour.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p5">2. In battle, she calls the next Naphtali,
Wrestlings, saying, I have wrestled with my sister, and have prevailed -
See what roots of bitterness envy and strife are, and what mischief they
make among relations!</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p6">9. Rachel had done that absurd and preposterous thing of
putting her maid into her husband's bed, and now Leah (because she
missed one year in bearing children) doth the same, to be even with her.
See the power of rivalship, and admire the wisdom of the divine
appointment, which joins together one man and one woman only. Two sons
Zilpah bare to Jacob, whom Leah looked upon herself as intitled to, in
token of which she called one Gad, promising herself a little troop of
children. The other she called Asher, Happy, thinking herself happy in
him, and promising herself that her neighbours would think so too.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p7">14. Reuben, a little lad of five or six years old,
playing in the field, found mandrakes. It is uncertain what they were;
the critics are not agreed about them: we are sure they were some
rarities, either fruits or flowers that were very pleasant to the smell,
<scripRef passage="So vii. 13" id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Song|7|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Song.7.13">So vii, 13</scripRef>. Some think these mandrakes were Jessamin flowers. Whatever
they were, Rachel, could not see them in Leah's hands, but she must
covet them.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p8">17. And God hearkened unto Leah - Perhaps the reason of
this contest between Jacob's wives for his company, and their giving him
their maids to be his wives, was the earnest desire they had to fulfil
the promise made to Abraham (and now lately renewed to Jacob) that his
seed should be as the stars of heaven for multitude, and that, in one
seed of his, the Messiah, all the nations of the earth shall be blessed.
Two sons Leah was now blessed with; the flrst she called Issachar, a
hire, reckoning herself well repaid for her mandrakes; nay, (which is a
strange construction of the providence) rewarded for giving her maid to
her husband. The other she called Zebulun, dwelling, owning God's bounty
to her, God has endowed me with a good dowry. Jacob had not endowed her
when he married her; but she reckons a family of children, a good
dowry.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p9">21. Mention is made, of Dinah, because of the following
story concerning her, chap. xxxiv, 1-16, &amp;c. Perhaps Jacob had other
daughters, though not registered.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p10">22. God remembered Rachel, whom he seemed to have
forgotten, and hearkened to her, whose prayers had been long denied, and
then she bare a son. Rachael called her son Joseph, which, in Hebrew, is
a-kin to two words of a contrary signification: Asaph, abstulit, he has
taken away my reproach, as if the greatest mercy she had in this son
were, that she had saved her credit: and Joseph, addidit, the Lord shall
add to me another son: which may be looked upon as the language of her
faith; she takes this mercy as an earnest of further mercy: hath God
given me this grace? I may call it Joseph, and say, he shall add more
grace.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p11">34. Laban was willing to consent to this bargain, because
he thought if those few he had that were now speckled and spotted were
separated from the rest, which was to be done immediately, the body of
the flock which Jacob was to tend, being of one colour, either all black
or all white, would produce few or none of mixt colours, and so he
should have Jacob's service for nothing, or next to nothing. According
to this bargain, those few that were party-coloured were separated, and
put into the hands of Laban's sons, and sent three days journey off: so
great was Laban's jealouly lest any of those should mix with the rest of
the flock to the advantage of Jacob.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p12">37. Here is Jacob's policy to make his bargain more
advantageous to himself than it was likely to be: and if he had not
taken some course to help himself, it would have been an ill bargain
indeed; which he knew Laban would never have considered, who did not
consult any one's interest but his own.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p13">1. Now Jacob's contrivances were, He set
pilled sticks before the cattle where they were watered, that looking
much at those unusual party-coloured sticks, by the power of
imagination, they might bring forth young ones in like manner
party-coloured. Probably this custom was commonly used by the shepherds
of Canaan, who coveted to have their cattle of this motly colour.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxi.ii-p14">2. When he began to have a flock of
ring-straked and brown, he contrived to set them first, and to put the
faces of the rest towards them, with the same design as he did the
former. Whether this was honest policy, or no, may admit of a question.
Read chap. xxxi, 7- 16, and the question is resolved.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXI" progress="35.93%" prev="ii.ii.xxxi.ii" next="ii.ii.xxxii.i" id="ii.ii.xxxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXXI" id="ii.ii.xxxii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|31|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.31" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxxii-p0.2">XXXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 31" progress="35.93%" prev="ii.ii.xxxii" next="ii.ii.xxxii.ii" id="ii.ii.xxxii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.i-p1">Jacob was in general, a man of devotion and integrity;
yet he had more trouble than any of the patriarchs. Here is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxii.i-p2">I. His resolution to return, ver. 1-16.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxii.i-p3">II. His clandestine departure, ver.
17-21.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxii.i-p4">III. Laban's pursuit of him in displeasure,
ver. 22-25.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxii.i-p5">IV. The hot words that passed between them,
ver. 26-42.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxii.i-p6">V. Their amicable agreement at last, ver.
43-55.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 31" progress="35.94%" prev="ii.ii.xxxii.i" next="ii.ii.xxxiii" id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p1">1. It should seem they said it in Jacob's hearing. The
last chapter began with Rachel's envying Leah; this begins with Laban's
sons envying Jacob. He has gotten all his glory - And what was this
glory? It was a parcel of brown sheep and speckled goats, and some
camels and asses. Jacob has taken away all that was our fathers - Not
all, sure; what was become of those cattle which were committed to the
custody of Laban's sons, and sent three days journey off?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p2">3. The Lord said unto Jacob, Return and I will be with
thee - though Jacob had met with very hard usage, yet he would not quit
his place 'till God bid him. He came thither by orders from heaven, and
there he would slay 'till he was ordered back. The direction he had from
heaven is more fully related in the account he gives of it to his wives,
where he tells them of the dream he had about the cattle, and the
wonderful increase of those of his colour; and how the angel of God in
that dream instructed him that it was not by chance, nor by his own
policy, that he obtained that great advantage but by the providence of
God, who had taken notice of the hardships Laban had put upon him, and
in performance of his promise.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p3">4. And Jacob sent for Rachel and Leah to the field - That
he might discourse with them more privately.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p4">9. God hath taken away the cattle of your father and
given them to me - Thus the righteous God paid Jacob for his hard
service out of Laban's estate; as afterwards he paid the seed of Jacob
for their service of the Egyptians with their spoils.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p5">16. Whereas Jacob looked upon the wealth which God had
passed over from Laban to him as his wages, they look upon it as their
portions; so that both ways God forced Laban to pay his debts, both to
his servant and to his daughters.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p6">19. Laban went to shear his sheep - That part of his
flock which was in the hands of his sons, three days journey off. Now,
(1.) It is certain it was lawful for Jacob to leave his service
suddenly: it was not only justified by the particular instructions God
gave him, but warranted by the fundamental law of self- preservation
which directs us, when we are in danger, to shift for our own safety, as
far as we can do it without wronging our consciences. (2.) It was his
prudence to steal away unawares to Laban, lest if Laban had known, he
should have hindered him, or plundered him. (3.) It was honestly done to
take no more than his own with him, the cattle of his getting. He took
what providence gave him, and would not take the repair of his damages
into his own hands. Yet Rachel was not so honest as her husband; she
stole her father's images, and carried them away. The Hebrew calls them
Teraphim. Some think they were only little representations of the
ancestors of the family in statue or picture, which Rachel had a
particular fondness for, and was desirous to have with her now she was
going into another country. It should rather seem they were images for a
religious use, penates, household gods, either worshipped, or consulted
as oracles; and we are willing to hope, that she took them away, not out
of covetousness much less for her own use, or out of any superstitious
fear lest Laban, by consulting his teraphim, might know which way they
were gone; (Jacob no doubt dwelt with his wives as a man of knowledge,
and they were better taught than so) but with a design to convince her
father of the folly of his regard to those as gods which could not
secure themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p7">23. He took his brethren -- that is, his relations, and
pursues Jacob to bring him back into bondage, or, to strip him of what
he had.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p8">24. Speak not, either good or bad - That is, say nothing
against his going on with his journey, for the thing proceedeth from the
Lord. The same Hebraism we have, chap. xxiv, 50. The safety of good men
is very much owing to the hold God has of the consciences of bad men,
and the access he has to them.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p9">27. I might have sent thee away with mirth and with
songs, with tabret and with harp - Not as Rebekah was sent away out of
the same family above one hundred and twenty years before, with prayers
and blessings, but with sport and merriment; which was a sign that
religion was much decayed in the family.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p10">29. It is in the power of my hand to do you hurt - He
supposeth that he had both right on his side, and strength on his side,
either to revenge the wrong, or recover the right. Yet he owns himself
under the restraint of God's power; he durst not injure one of whom he
saw to be the particular care of heaven.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p11">30. Wherefore hast thou stolen my gods? - Foolish man! to
call those his gods that could be stolen! Could he expect protection
from them that could neither resist nor discover their invaders? Happy
are they who have the Lord for their God. Enemies may steal our goods,
but not our God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p12">31. Jacob clears himself by giving the true reason why he
went away unknown to Laban; he feared lest Laban would by force take
away his daughters and so oblige him to continue in his service. As to
the charge of stealing Laban's gods, he pleads not guilty. He not only
did not take them himself, but he did not know that they were taken.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p13">42. Jacob speaks of God as the God of his father,
intimating that he thought himself unworthy to be thus regarded, but was
beloved for his father's sake. He calls him the God of Abraham and the
fear of Isaac: for Abraham was dead, and gone to that world where there
is no fear; but Isaac was yet alive, sanctifying the Lord in his heart
as his fear and his dread.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p14">43. All his mine - That is, came by me.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p15">44. Let us make a covenant - It was made and ratified
with great solemnity, according to the usages of those times.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p16">1. A pillar was erected, and a heap of
stones raised, to perpetuate the memory of the thing, writing being then
not known.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p17">2. A sacrifice was offered, a sacrifice of
peace-offerings.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p18">3. They did eat bread together, jointly
partaking of the feast upon the sacrifice. This was in token of a hearty
reconciliation. Covenants of friendship were anciently ratified by the
parties eating and drinking together.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p19">4. They solemnity appealed to God
concerning their sincerity herein; (1.) As a witness, ver. 49. The Lord
watch between me and thee - That is, the Lord take cognizance of every
thing that shall be done on either side in violation of this league.
(2.) As a judge, The God of Abraham, from whom Jacob was descended, and
The God of Nahor, from whom Laban was descended, the God of their
father, the common ancestor from whom they were both descended, judge
betwixt us. God's relation to them is thus expressed, to intimate that
they worshipped one and the same God, upon which consideration there
ought to be no enmity betwixt them. Those that have one God should have
one heart: God is judge between contending parties, and he will judge
righteously, whoever doth wrong it is at their peril.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p20">5. They gave a new name to the place, ver.
47, 48. Laban called it in Syriac, and Jacob in Hebrew, The heap of
witness. And ver. 49, it was called Mizpah, a watch-tower. Posterity
being included in the league, care was taken that thus the memory of it
should be preserved. The name Jacob gave this heap stuck by it, Galeed,
not the name Laban gave it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxii.ii-p21">54. And Jacob swear by the fear of his father Isaac - The
God whom his father Isaac feared, who had never served other gods, as
Abraham and Nahor had done.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXII" progress="36.07%" prev="ii.ii.xxxii.ii" next="ii.ii.xxxiii.i" id="ii.ii.xxxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXXII" id="ii.ii.xxxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|32|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.32" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxxiii-p0.2">XXXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 32" progress="36.07%" prev="ii.ii.xxxiii" next="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.i-p1">We have here Jacob still upon his journey towards Canaan.
Never did so many memorable things occur in any march, as in this in
Jacob's little family. By the way he meets,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.i-p2">I. With good tidings from his God, ver. 1,
2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.i-p3">II. With bad tidings from his brother, to
whom he sent a message to notify his return, ver. 2-7. In his
distress,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.i-p4">1. He divides his company, ver. 8.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.i-p5">2. He makes his prayer to God, ver.
9-12.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.i-p6">3. He sends a present to his brother, ver.
13-23.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.i-p7">4. He wrestles with the angel, ver.
24-32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 32" progress="36.07%" prev="ii.ii.xxxiii.i" next="ii.ii.xxxiv" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p1">1. And the Angel of God met him - In a visible
appearance; whether in a vision by day, or in a dream by night, as when
he saw them upon the ladder, is uncertain. They met him to bid him
welcome to Canaan again; a more honourable reception than ever any
prince had that was met by the magistrates of a city. They met him to
congratulate his arrival, and his escape from Laban. They had invisibly
attended him all along, but now they appeared, because he had greater
dangers before him. When God designs his people for extraordinary
trials, he prepares them by extraordinary comforts.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p2">2. This is God's house - A good man may, with an eye of
faith, see the same that Jacob saw with his bodily eyes. What need we
dispute whether he has a guardian angel, when we are sure he has a guard
of angels about him? To preserve the remembrance of this favour, Jacob
gave a name to the place from it, Mahanaim, two hosts, or two camps
probably they appeared to him in two hosts, one on either side, or one
in the front, and the other in the rear, to protect him from Laban
behind, and Esau before, that they might be a compleat guard. Here was
Jacob's family that made one army, representing the church militant and
itinerant on earth; and the angels another army, representing the church
triumphant, and at rest in heaven.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p3">4. He calls Esau his Lord, himself his servant, to
intimate that he did not insist upon the prerogatives of the birth-right
and blessing he had obtained for himself, but left it to God to fulfil
his own purpose in his seed. He gives him a short account of himself,
that he was not a fugitive and a vagabond, but though long absent had
dwelt with his own relations. I have sojourned with Laban, and staid
there till now: and that he was not a beggar, nor likely to be a charge
to his relations; no, I have oxen and asses - This he knew would (if any
thing) recommend him to Esau's good affection. And, he courts his
favour; I have sent that I may find grace in thy sight - It is no
disparagement to those that have the better cause to become petitioners
for reconciliation, and to sue for peace as well as right.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p4">6. He cometh to meet thee, and four hundred men with him
- He is now weary of waiting for the days of mourning for his father,
and before those come resolves to slay his brother. Out he marches with
four hundred men, probably such as used to hunt with him, armed no
doubt, ready to execute the word of command.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p5">7. Then Jacob was greatly afraid and distressed - A
lively apprehension of danger, may very well consist with a humble
confidence in God's power and promise.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p6">9. He addresseth himself to God as the God of his
fathers: such was the sense he had of his own unworthiness, that he did
not call God his own God, but a God in covenant with his ancestors. O
God of my father Abraham, and God of my father Isaac. And this he could
better plead, because the covenant was entailed upon him. Thou saidst
unto me, Return unto thy country - He did not rashly leave his place
with Laban, out of a foolish fondness for his native country; but in
obedience to God's command.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p7">10. I am not worthy - It is a surprising plea. One would
think he should have pleaded that what was now in danger was his own
against all the world, and that he had earned it dear enough; no, he
pleads, Lord, I am not worthy of it. Of the least of all the mercies -
Here is mercies in the plural number, an inexhaustible spring, and
innumerable streams; mercies and truth, past mercies given according to
the promise and farther mercies secured by the promise. I am not worthy
of the least of all the mercies, much less am I worthy of so great a
favour as this I am now suing for. Those are best prepared for the
greatest mercies that see themselves unworthy of the least. For with my
staff I passed over this Jordan - Poor and desolate, like a forlorn and
despised pilgrim: He had no guides, no companions, no attendants. And
now I am become two bands - Now I am surrounded with a numerous retinue
of children and servants. Those whose latter end doth greatly increase,
ought with humility and thankfulness to remember how small their
beginning was.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p8">11. Lord, deliver me from Esau, for I fear him - The fear
that quickens prayer is itself pleadable. It was not a robber, but a
murderer that he was afraid of: nor was it his own life only that lay at
stake, but the mothers, and the childrens.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p9">12. Thou saidst, I will surely do thee good - The best we
can say to God in prayer is, what he hath said to us. God's promises as
they are the surest guide of our desires in prayer, and furnish us with
the best petitions, so they are the firmest ground of our hopes, and
furnish us with the best pleas. Thou saidst, I will do thee good - Lord,
do me good in this matter. He pleads also a particular promise, that of
the multiplying of his seed. Lord, what will become of that promise, if
they be all cut off?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p10">13. Jacob having piously made God his friend by a prayer,
is here prudently endeavouring to make Esau his friend by a present. He
had prayed to God to deliver him from the hand of Esau - His prayer did
not make him presume upon God's mercy, without the use of means.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p11">17. He sent him also a very humble message, which he
ordered his servants to deliver in the best manner. They must call Esau
their Lord, and Jacob his servant: they must tell him the cattle they
had was a small present which Jacob had sent him. They must especially
take care to tell him that Jacob was coming after, that he might not
suspect him fled. A friendly confidence in mens goodness may help to
prevent the mischief designed us by their badness.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p12">24. Very early in the morning, a great while before day.
Jacob had helped his wives and children over the river, and he desired
to be private, and was left alone, that he might again spread his cares
and fears before God in prayer. While Jacob was earnest in prayer,
stirring up himself to take hold on God, an angel takes hold on him.
Some think this was a created angel, one of those that always behold the
face of our Father. Rather it was the angel of the covenant, who often
appeared in a human shape, before he assumed the human nature. We are
told by the prophet, <scripRef passage="Hosea xii. 4" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Hos|12|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.12.4">Hosea xii, 4</scripRef>, how Jacob wrestled, he wept and made supplication; prayers
and tears were his weapons. It was not only a corporal, but a spiritual
wrestling by vigourous faith and holy desire.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p13">25. The angel prevailed not against him - That is, this
discouragement did not shake his faith, nor silence his prayer. It was
not in his own strength that he wrestled, nor by his own strength that
he prevails; but by strength derived from heaven. That of Job
illustrates this, <scripRef passage="Job xxiii. 6" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Job|23|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.23.6">Job xxiii,
6</scripRef>. Will he plead against me with his great power? No; had the
angel done so, Jacob had been crushed; but he would put strength in me:
and by that strength Jacob had power over the angel, <scripRef passage="Hosea xii. 3" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p13.2" parsed="|Hos|12|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.12.3">Hosea xii, 3</scripRef>. The angel put out Jacob's thigh, to shew him what he could
do, and that it was God he was wrestling with, for no man could disjoint
his thigh with a touch. Some think that Jacob felt little or no pain
from this hurt; it is probable be did not, for he did not so much as
halt 'till the struggle was over, ver. 31, and if so, that was an
evidence of a divine touch indeed, which wounded and healed at the same
time.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p14">26. Let me go - The angel, by an admirable condescension,
speaks Jacob fair to let him go, as God said to Moses, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxii. 10" id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Exod|32|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.32.10">Exod. xxxii, 10</scripRef>. Let me alone. Could not a mighty angel get clear of Jacob's
grapples? He could; but thus he would put an honour upon Jacob's faith
and prayer. The reason the angel gives why he would be gone is because
the day breaks, and therefore he would not any longer detain Jacob, who
had business to do, a journey to go, a family to look after. And he
said, I will not let thee go except thou bless me - He resolves he will
have a blessing, and rather shall all his bones be put out of joint,
than he will go away without one. Those that would have the blessing of
Christ must be in good earnest, and be importunate for it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p15">27. What is thy name? - Jacob (saith he) a supplanter, so
Jacob signifies. Well, (faith the angel) be thou never so called any
more: thou shalt be called Israel, a prince with God. He is a prince
indeed, that is a prince with God; and those are truly honourable that
are mighty, in prayer. Yet this was not all; having, power with God, he
shall have power with men too; having prevailed for a blessing from
heaven, he shall, no doubt, prevail for Esau's favour. Whatever enemies
we have, if we can but make God our friend, we are well enough; they
that by faith have power in heaven, have thereby as much power on earth
as they have occasion for.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p16">29. Wherefore dost thou ask after my name? - What good
will it do thee to know that? The discovery of that was reserved for his
death-bed, upon which he was taught to call him Shiloh. But instead of
telling him his name, he gave him his blessing, which was the thing he
wrestled for; he blessed him there, repeated and ratified the blessing
formerly given him. See how wonderfully God condescends to countenance
and crown importunate prayer? Those that resolve though God slay them,
yet to trust in him, will at length be more than conquerors.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p17">30. Peniel - That is, the face of God, because there he
had seen the appearance of God, and obtained the favour of God.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii-p18">31. He halted on his thigh - And some think he continued
to do so to his dying day. If he did, he had no reason to complain, for
the honour and comfort he obtained by his struggle was abundantly
sufficient to countervail the damage, though he went limping to his
grave.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIII" progress="36.24%" prev="ii.ii.xxxiii.ii" next="ii.ii.xxxiv.i" id="ii.ii.xxxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXXIII" id="ii.ii.xxxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|33|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.33" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxxiv-p0.2">XXXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 33" progress="36.24%" prev="ii.ii.xxxiv" next="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.i-p1">We read in the former chapter how Jacob had power with
God, and prevailed; here we find what power he had with men too. Here
is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.i-p2">I. A friendly meeting between Jacob and
Esau, ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.i-p3">II. Their conference at their meeting.
Their discourse is, (1.) About Jacob's family, ver. 5-7. (2.) About the
present he had sent, ver. 8-11. (3.) About the progress of their
journey, ver. 12-15.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.i-p4">III. Jacob's settlement in Canaan, his
house-ground, and altar, ver. 16-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 33" progress="36.25%" prev="ii.ii.xxxiv.i" next="ii.ii.xxxv" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p1">3. He bowed - Though he feared Esau as an enemy, yet he
did obeisance to him as an elder brother.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p2">4. And Esau ran to meet him - Not in passion but in love.
Embraced him, fell on his neck and kissed him - God hath the hearts of
all men in his hands, and can turn them when and how he pleases. He can
of a sudden convert enemies into friends, as he did two Sauls, one by
restraining grace, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxvi. 21, 25" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|1Sam|26|21|0|0;|1Sam|26|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.26.21 Bible:1Sam.26.25">1 Sam. xxvi, 21, 25</scripRef>, the other by renewing grace, <scripRef passage="Acts ix. 21" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Acts|9|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.9.21">Acts ix,
21</scripRef>. And they wept - Jacob wept for joy to be thus kindly
received; Esau perhaps wept for grief and shame to think of the ill
design he had conceived against his brother.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p3">5. Eleven or twelve little ones followed Jacob, the
eldest of them not fourteen years old: Who are these? saith Esau. Jacob
had sent him an account of the increase of his estate, but made no
mention of his children, perhaps because he would not expose them to his
rage, if he should meet him as an enemy. Esau therefore had reason to
ask who are those with thee? To which Jacob returns a serious answer;
they are the children which God hath graciously given thy servant. Jacob
speaks of his children,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p4">1. As God's gifts; they are a heritage of
the Lord.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p5">2. As choice gifts; he hath graciously
given them. Though they were many, and but slenderly provided for, yet
he accounts them great blessings.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p6">10. I have seen thy face as though I had seen the face of
God - That is, I have seen thee reconciled to me, and at peace with me,
as I desire to see God reconciled.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p7">12. Esau offers himself to be his guide and companion, in
token of sincere reconciliation. We never find that Jacob and Esau were
so loving with one another as they were now. God made Esau not only not
an enemy, but a friend. Esau is become fond of Jacob's company, courts
him to mount Seir: let us never despair of any, nor distrust God, in
whose hands all hearts are. Yet Jacob saw cause modestly to refute this
offer, wherein he shews a tender concern for his own family and flocks,
like a good shepherd and a good father. He must consider the children,
and the flocks with young, and not lead the one or drive the other too
fast. Jacob intimates to him, that it was his design to come to him to
mount Seir; and we may presume he did so, after he had settled his
concerns elsewhere, though that visit be not recorded.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p8">15. Esau offers some of his men to be his guard and
convoy; but Jacob humbly refuseth his offer, only desiring he would not
take it amiss that he did not accept it. What needs it? He is under the
Divine protection. Those are sufficiently guarded that have God for
their guard, and are under a convoy of his hosts, as Jacob was. Jacob
adds, only let me find grace in the sight of my Lord - Having thy favour
I have all I need, all I desire from thee.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p9">16. And Jacob journeyed to Succoth - Having in a friendly
manner parted with Esau, who was gone to his own country, he comes to a
place, where he rested, set up booths for his cattle, and other
conveniences for himself and family. The place was afterwards known by
the name of Succoth, a city in the tribe of Gad, on the other side
Jordan; it signifies booths: that when his posterity afterwards dwelt in
houses of stone, they might remember that the Syrian ready to perish was
their father, who was glad of booths, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxvi. 5" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Deut|26|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.26.5">Deut. xxvi, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p10">18. And Jacob came to Shalem, a city of Shechem - Or
rather he came safe, or in peace, to the city of Shechem. After a
perilous journey, in which he had met with many difficulties, he came
safe at last, into Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p11">20. He erected an altar -</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p12">1. In thankfulness to God for the good hand
of his providence over him.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii-p13">2. That he might keep up religion, and the
worship of God in his family. He dedicated this altar to the honour of
El-elohe-israel, God-the God of Israel: to the honour of God in general,
the only living and true God, the Best of beings, the First of causes:
and to the honour of the God of Israel, as a God in covenant with him.
God had lately called him by the name of Israel; and now he calls God
the God of Israel; though he be called a prince with God, God shall
still be a prince with him, his Lord and his God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIV" progress="36.33%" prev="ii.ii.xxxiv.ii" next="ii.ii.xxxv.i" id="ii.ii.xxxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXXIV" id="ii.ii.xxxv-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|34|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.34" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxxv-p0.2">XXXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 34" progress="36.33%" prev="ii.ii.xxxv" next="ii.ii.xxxv.ii" id="ii.ii.xxxv.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.i-p1">In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxv.i-p2">1. Dinah debauched, ver. 1, 2-5.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxv.i-p3">2. A treaty of marriage between her and
Shechem who had defiled her, ver. 6-19.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxv.i-p4">3. The circumcision of the Shechemites,
pursuant to that treaty, ver. 20-24.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxv.i-p5">4. The perfidious and bloody revenge which
Simeon and Levi took upon them, ver. 25-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 34" progress="36.33%" prev="ii.ii.xxxv.i" next="ii.ii.xxxvi" id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii-p1">1. Dinah was then about fifteen or sixteen years of age
when she went out to see the daughters of the land - Probably on some
public day. She went to see; yet that was not all, she went to be seen
too: she went to see the daughters of the land, but it may be with some
thoughts of the sons of the land too.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii-p2">7. It is called folly in Israel - According to the
language of after- times, for Israel was not yet a people, but a family
only.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii-p3">8. Hamor communed - That is, talked. He came to treat
with Jacob himself, but he turns them over to his sons. And here we have
a particular account of the treaty, in which it is a shame to say the
Canaanites were more honest than the Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii-p4">18. Hamor and Shechem gave consent themselves to be
circumcised. To this perhaps they were moved not only by the strong
desire they had to bring about, this match, but by what they might have
heard of the sacred and honourable intentions of this sign, in the
family of Abraham, which it is probable they had some confused notions
of, and of the promises confirmed by it; which made them the more
desirous to incorporate with the family of Jacob.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii-p5">23. Shall not their cattle and their substance be ours? -
They observed that Jacob's sons were industrious, thriving people, and
promised themselves and their neighbours advantage by an alliance with
them: it would improve ground and trade, and bring money into their
country.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii-p6">25. They slew all the males - Nothing can excuse this
execrable villainy. It was true Shechem had wrought folly in Israel, in
defiling Dinah: but it ought to have been considered how far Dinah
herself had been accessary to it. Had Shechem abused her in her mother's
tent, it had been another matter; but she went upon his ground, and
struck the spark which began the fire. When we are severe upon the
sinner, we ought to consider who was the tempter. It was true that
Shechem had done ill; but he was endeavouring to atone for it, and was
as honest and honourable afterwards as the case would admit. It was true
that Shechem had done ill, but what was that to all the Shechemites?
Doth one man sin, and must the innocent fall with the guilty? This was
barbarous indeed. But that which above all aggravated the cruelty, was
the most perfidious treachery that was in it. The Shechemites had
submitted to their conditions, and had done that upon which they had
promised to become one people with them. Yet they act as sworn enemies
to those to whom they were lately become sworn friends, making as light
of their covenant as they did of the laws of humanity. And these are the
sons of Israel? Cursed be their anger, for it was fierce.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii-p7">27. Tho' Simeon and Levi only were the murderers, yet
others of the sons of Jacob came upon the slain, and spoiled the city -
And so became accessary to the murder.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii-p8">30. Ye have troubled me, to make me to stink among the
inhabitants of the land - That is, You have rendered my family odious
among them. And what could be expected but that the Canaanites, who were
numerous and formidable, would confederate against him, and he and his
little family would become an easy prey to them? I shall be destroyed, I
and my house - Jacob knew indeed that God had promised to preserve his
house; but he might justly fear that these vile practices of his
children would amount to a forfeiture, and cut off the entail. When sin
is in the house, there is reason to fear ruin at the door.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxv.ii-p9">31. Should he deal with our sister as with an harlot? -
No, he should not; but, if he do, Must they be their own avengers? And
nothing less than so many lives, and the ruin of a whole city, serve to
atone for the abuse.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXV" progress="36.40%" prev="ii.ii.xxxv.ii" next="ii.ii.xxxvi.i" id="ii.ii.xxxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXXV" id="ii.ii.xxxvi-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|35|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.35" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxxvi-p0.2">XXXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 35" progress="36.40%" prev="ii.ii.xxxvi" next="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p1">In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p2">I. Three communions between God and
Jacob.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p3">1. God ordered Jacob to Beth-el, and in
obedience to that order, he purged his house of idols, and prepared for
that journey, ver. 1-5.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p4">2. Jacob built an altar at Beth-el to the
honour of God that had appeared to him, and in performance of his vow,
ver. 6, 7.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p5">3. God appeared to him again, and confirmed
the change of his name, and the covenant with him, ver 9-13. of which
appearance Jacob made a grateful acknowledgement, ver. 14, 15.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p6">II. Three funerals.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p7">1. Deborah's, ver. 8.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p8">2. Rachel's, ver. 16-20.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p9">3. Isaac's, ver. 27-29.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.i-p10">III. Here is also Reuben's incest, ver. 22.
and an account of Jacob's sons, ver. 23-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 35" progress="36.41%" prev="ii.ii.xxxvi.i" next="ii.ii.xxxvii" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p1">1. Arise go to Bethel - Here God minds Jacob of his vow
at Beth- el, and sends him thither to perform it, Jacob had said in the
day of his distress, If I come again in peace, this stone shall be God's
house, chap. xxviii, 22. God had performed his part, had given Jacob
more than bread to eat, and raiment to put on; but it should seem he had
forgotten his vow, or, at least, deferred the performance of it. And
dwell there - That is, Not only go himself, but take his family with
him, that they might join with him in his devotions. Put away the
strange Gods - Strange God's in Jacob's family! Could such a family,
that was taught the knowledge of the Lord, admit them? Could such a
master, to whom God had appeared twice, and oftner, connive at them? And
be clean, and change your garments - These were ceremonies signifying
the purification and change of the heart.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p2">4. And they gave to Jacob - His servants, and even the
retainers to his family, gave him all the strange gods, and the
ear-rings they wore either as charms, or to the honour of their gods.
Jacob took care to bury their images, we may suppose, in some place
unknown to them, that they might not afterwards find and return to
them.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p3">5. And the terror of God was upon the cities - Though the
Canaanites were much exasperated against the sons of Jacob for their
barbarous usage of the Shechemites; yet they were so restrained by a
divine power, that they could not take this fair opportunity to avenge
their neighbours quarrel. God governs the world more by secret terrors
on men's minds than we are aware of.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p4">7. He built an altar - And no doubt offered sacrifice
upon it, perhaps the tenth of his cattle, according to his vow, I will
give the tenth unto thee. And he called the place, That is, the altar,
El- beth-el, the God of Beth-el. As when he made a thankful
acknowledgement of the honour God had done him in calling him Israel, he
worshipped God by the name of El-elohe-israel, so now he was making a
grateful recognition of God's former favour at Beth-el, he worships God
by the name of El-beth-el, the God of Beth-el, because there God
appeared to him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p5">8. There he buried Deborah, Rebekah's nurse - We have
reason to think that Jacob, after he came to Canaan, while his family
dwelt near Shechem, went himself to visit his father Isaac at Hebron.
Rebekah probably was dead, but her old nurse (of whom mention is made
chap. xxiv, 59,) survived her, and Jacob took her to his family. While
they were at Beth-el she died, and died lamented, so much lamented, that
the oak under which she was buried, was called Allon-bachuth, the oak of
weeping.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p6">10. God now confirmed the change of his name. It was done
before by the angel that wrestled with him, chap. xxxii, 28, and here it
was ratified by the divine majesty, to encourage him against the fear of
the Canaanites. Who can be too hard for Israel, a prince with God?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p7">11. He renewed and ratified the covenant with him, by the
name of El-Shaddai, I am God Almighty. God All-sufficient, able to make
good the promise in due time, and to support thee and provide for thee.
Two things are promised him. 1. That he should be the father of a great
nation: great in number, a company of nations shall be of thee - Every
tribe of Israel was a nation, and all the twelve, a company of nations:
great in honour and power, kings shall come out of thy loins. 2. That he
should be master of a good land, ver. 12. The land that was given to
Abraham and Isaac is here entailed on Jacob and his seed. These two
promises had also a spiritual signification, which we may suppose Jacob
himself had some notion of: for without doubt Christ is the promised
seed, and heaven is the promised land; the former is the foundation, and
the latter the top-stone of all God's favours.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p8">13. And God went up from him - Or, from over him - In
some visible display of glory, which had hovered over him, while he
talked with him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p9">14. And Jacob set up a pillar - When he was going to
Padan-aram he set up that stone which he had laid his head on for a
pillar; but now he took time to erect one more stately, and durable,
probably inserting that stone into it. And in token of his intending it
for a sacred memorial of his communion with God, he poured oil, and the
other ingredients of a drink-offering upon it. This stone shall be God's
house, that is, shall be set up for his honour, as houses to the praise
of their builders; and here he performs it. And he confirmed the name he
had formerly given to the place, Beth-el, the house of God. Yet this
very place afterwards lost the honour of its name, and became Beth-aven,
a house of iniquity, for here it was that Jeroboam set up one of his
calves. It is impossible for the best men to entail so much as the
profession and form of religion upon a place.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p10">16. She had hard labour - Harder than usual.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p11">17. Rachel had said when she bore Joseph, God shall give
me another son, which now the midwife remembers, and tells her, her
words were made good. Yet this did not avail; unless God command away
fear, no one else can. We are apt in extreme perils to comfort ourselves
and our friends with the hopes of a temporal deliverance, in which we
may be disappointed; we had better ground our comforts on that which
cannot fail us, the hope of eternal life. Rachel had passionately said,
Give me children, or else I die; and now she had children (for this was
her second) she died.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p12">18. Her dying lips calls her new-born soon Benoni, the
son of my sorrow. But Jacob because he would not renew the sorrowful
remembrance of his mother's death every time he called his son by name,
changed his name, and called him Benjamin, the son of my right hand -
That is, very dear to me; set on my right hand for a right hand
blessing; the support of my age, like the staff in my right hand. Jacob
buried her near the place where she died. If the soul be at rest after
death, the matter is not great where the body lies. In the place where
the tree falls, there let it lie. The Jewish writers say, The death of
Deborah and Rachel was to expiate the murder of the Shechemites,
occasioned by Dinah, a daughter of the family.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p13">20. And Jacob set up a pillar upon her grave - So that it
was known long after to be Rachel's sepulchre, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. x. 2" id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p13.1" parsed="|1Sam|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.10.2">1 Sam. x, 2</scripRef>, and Providence so ordered it, that this place afterwards
fell in the lot of Benjamin. Jacob set up a pillar in remembrance of his
joys ver. 14, and here he set up one in remembrance of his sorrows; for
as it may be of use to ourselves to keep both in mind, so it may be of
use to others to transmit the memorials of both.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p14">21. Israel, a prince with God, yet dwells in tents; the
city is reserved for him in the other world.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p15">22. When Israel dwelt in that land - As if he were then
absent from his family, which might be the unhappy occasion of these
disorders. Though perhaps Bilhah was the greater criminal, yet Reuben's
crime was so provoking that for it he lost his birth-right and blessing,
chap. xlix, 4. And Israel heard it - No more is said, that is enough; he
heard it with the utmost grief and shame, horror and displeasure.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p16">27. And Jacob came unto Isaac his father - We may suppose
he had visited him before since his return, for he sore longed after his
father's house, but never 'till now brought his family to settle with
him, or near him. Probably he did this now upon the death of Rebekah, by
which Isaac was left solitary.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii-p17">28. The age and death of Isaac are here recorded, though
it appears by computation that he died not 'till many years after Joseph
was sold into Egypt, and much about the time that he was preferred
there. Isaac, a mild quiet man, lived the longest of all the patriarchs,
for he was one hundred and eighty years old: Abraham was but one hundred
and seventy-five. Isaac lived about forty years after he had made his
will, chap. xxvii, 2. We shall not die an hour the sooner, but abundance
the better, for our timely setting of our heart and house in order.
Particular notice is taken of the amicable agreement of Esau and Jacob
in solemnizing their father's funeral, ver. 29, to shew how God had
wonderfully changed Esau's mind, since he vowed his brother's murder,
upon his father's death, chap. xxvii, 41. God has many ways of
preventing ill men from doing the mischief they in tended; he can either
tie their hands, or turn their hearts.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXVI" progress="36.55%" prev="ii.ii.xxxvi.ii" next="ii.ii.xxxvii.i" id="ii.ii.xxxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXXVI" id="ii.ii.xxxvii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|36|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.36" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxxvii-p0.2">XXXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 36" progress="36.56%" prev="ii.ii.xxxvii" next="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p1">In this chapter we have an account of the posterity of
Esau, who were from him, were called Edomites;</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p2">1. Because he was the son of Isaac, for
whose sake this honour is put upon him.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p3">2. Because the Edomites were neighbours to
Israel, and their genealogy would be of use to give light to the
following stories of what passed between them.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p4">3. To shew the performance of the promise
to Abraham, that he should be the father of many nations, and of that
answer which Rebekah had from the oracle she consulted, Two nations are
in thy womb; and of the blessing of Isaac, Thy dwelling shall be the
fatness of the earth. Here are,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p5">I. Esau's wives, ver. 1-5.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p6">II. His remove to mount Seir, ver. 6-8.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p7">III. The names of his sons, ver. 9-14.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p8">IV. The dukes which descended of his sons,
ver. 15-19.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p9">V. The dukes of the Horites, ver.
20-30.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.i-p10">VI. The kings and dukes of Edom, ver.
31-43.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 36" progress="36.57%" prev="ii.ii.xxxvii.i" next="ii.ii.xxxviii" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p1">1. Who is Edom-That name perpetuated the remembrance of
the foolish bargain he made, when he sold his birth-right for that red
pottage.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p2">6. Esau had begun to settle among his wife's relations in
Seir, before Jacob came from Padan-aram, chap. xxxii, 3. Isaac it is
likely, had sent him thither, that Jacob might have the clearer way to
the possession of the promised land: yet probably during the life of
Isaac, Esau had still some effects remaining in Canaan; but after his
death, he wholly withdrew to mount Seir, took with him what came to his
share of his father's personal estate, and left Canaan to Jacob, not
only because he had the promise of it, but because he saw, if they
should both continue to thrive, as they had begun, there would not be
room for both.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p3">8. Thus dwelt Esau in mount Seir - Whatever opposition
may be made, God's word will take place, and even those that have
opposed it will see themselves, some time or other, under a necessity of
yielding to it. Esau had struggled for Canaan, but now he retires to
mount Seir; for God's counsels shall certainly stand concerning the
times before appointed, and the bounds of our habitation.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p4">10. These are the names - Observe here,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p5">1. That only the names of Esau's sons and
grand-sons are recorded: not their history, for it is the church that
Moses preserves the records of, not of those that were without. The
elders only that lived by faith obtained a good report. Nor doth the
genealogy go any farther than the third and fourth generation, the very
names of all after are buried in oblivion; it is only the pedigree of
the Israelites who were to be the heirs of Canaan, and of whom were to
come the promised seed, and the holy seed, that is drawn out to any
length, as far as there was occasion for it, even of all the tribes till
Canaan was divided among them, and of the royal line 'till Christ
came.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p6">2. That the sons and grand-sons of Esau are
called dukes. Probably they were military commanders, dukes or captains
that had soldiers under them; for Esau and his family lived by the
sword, chap. xxvii, 40.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p7">3. We may suppose those dukes had numerous
families of children and servants. God promised to multiply Jacob and to
enrich him, yet Esau increases and is enriched first. God's promise to
Jacob began to work late, but the effect of it remained longer, and it
had its compleat accomplishment in the spiritual Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p8">20. These are the sons of Seir - In the midst of the
genealogy of the Edomites is inserted the genealogy of the Horites,
those Canaanites, or Hittites, (compare chap. xxvi, 34,) that were the
natives of mount Seir. Mention is made of them, chap. xiv, 6, and of
their interest in mount Seir before the Edomites took possession of it, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 12, 22" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Deut|2|12|0|0;|Deut|2|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.12 Bible:Deut.2.22">Deut. ii, 12, 22</scripRef>. This comes in here, not only to give light to the story,
but to be a standing reflexion upon the Edomites for intermarrying with
them, by which it is likely they learned their way, and corrupted
themselves. Esau having sold his birth-right, and lost his blessing and
entered into alliance with the Hittites, his posterity and the sons of
Seir are here reckoned together. Those that treacherously desert God's
church are justly numbered with those that were never in it: apostate
Edomites stand on the same ground with accursed Horites. Notice is taken
of one Anah, who fed the asses of Zibeon his father, ver. 20, and yet is
called duke Anah, ver. 29. Those that expect to rise high should begin
low. An honourable descent should not keep men from an honest
employment, nor a mean employment baulk any man's preferment.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p9">24. This Anah was not only industrious in his business,
but ingenious too, and successful, for he found mules, or, (as some read
it) waters, hot baths in the wilderness. Those that are diligent in
their business sometimes find more advantages than they expected.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p10">31. By degrees the Edomites worked out the Horites, and
got full possession of the country. 1. They were ruled by kings who
governed the whole country, and seem to have come to the throne by
election, and not by lineal descent: these kings reigned in Edom before
there reigned any king over the children of Israel - That is, before
Moses's time, for he was king in Jeshurun. God had lately promised Jacob
that kings shall come out of his loins: yet Esau's blood becomes royal
long before any of Jacob's did. Probably it was a trial to the faith of
Israel, to hear of the power of the kings of Edom, while they were
bond-slaves in Egypt: but those that look for great things from God must
be content to wait for them. God's time is the best time. 2. They were
afterward's governed by dukes again, here named, who, I suppose, ruled
all at the same time in several places in the country. They set up this
form of government, either in conformity to the Horites, who had used
it, ver. 29, or God's providence reduced them to it, as some conjecture,
to correct them for their unkindness to Israel, in refusing them passage
through their country, <scripRef passage="Num. xx. 18" id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Num|20|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.20.18">Num. xx,
18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii-p11">43. Mount Seir is called the land of their possession -
While the Israelites dwelt in the house of bondage, and their Canaan was
only the land of promise, the Edomites dwelt in their own habitations,
and Seir was in their possession. The children of this world have their
all in hand, and nothing in hope, while the children of God have often
their all in hope, and next to nothing in hand. But, all things
considered, it is better to have Canaan in promise than mount Seir in
possession.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXVII" progress="36.67%" prev="ii.ii.xxxvii.ii" next="ii.ii.xxxviii.i" id="ii.ii.xxxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXXVII" id="ii.ii.xxxviii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|37|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.37" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxxviii-p0.2">XXXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 37" progress="36.67%" prev="ii.ii.xxxviii" next="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii" id="ii.ii.xxxviii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.i-p1">At this chapter begins the story of Joseph, Jacob's
eldest son, by his beloved wife Rachel. It is so remarkably divided
between his humiliation and his exaltation, that we cannot avoid seeing
something of Christ in it, who was first humbled and then exalted; it
also shews the lot of Christians, who must through many tribulations
enter into the kingdom. In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxviii.i-p2">I. The malice his brethren bore against
him: they hated him, (1.) Because he informed his father of their
wickedness, ver. 1, 2. (2.) Because his father loved him, ver. 3, 4.
(3.) Because he dreamed of his dominion over them, ver. 5-11.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxviii.i-p3">II. The mischiefs his brethren designed,
and did to him. (1.) His visit he made them gave an opportunity, ver.
12-17. (2.) They designed to slay him, but determined to starve him,
ver. 18-24. (3.) They changed their purpose, and sold him for a slave,
ver. 25- 28. (4.) They made their father believe that he was torn in
pieces, ver. 29-35. (5.) He was sold in Egypt to Potiphar, ver. xxxvi,
And all this was working together for good.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 37" progress="36.69%" prev="ii.ii.xxxviii.i" next="ii.ii.xxxix" id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p1">2. These are the generations of Jacob - It is not a
barren genealogy, as those of Esau, but a memorable useful history.
Joseph brought to his father their evil report - Jacob's sons did that
when they were from under his eye, which they durst not have done if
they had been at home with him; but Joseph gave his father an account of
their ill carriage, that he might reprove and restrain them.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p2">3. He made him a coat of divers colours - Which probably
was significant of farther honours intended him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p3">5. Though he was now very young, about seventeen years
old, yet he was pious and devout, and this fitted him for God's gracious
discoveries to him. Joseph had a great deal of trouble before him, and
therefore God gave him betimes this prospect of his advancement, to
support and comfort him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p4">8. Shalt thou indeed reign over us? - See here,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p5">1. How truly they interpreted his dream?
The event exactly answered this interpretation, chap. xlii, 6,
&amp;c.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p6">2. How scornfully they resented it, Shalt
thou that art but one, reign over us that are many? Thou that art the
youngest, over us that are elder? The reign of Jesus Christ, our Joseph,
is despised and striven against by an unbelieving world, who cannot
endure to think that this man should reign over them. The dominion also
of the upright in the morning of the resurrection is thought of with the
utmost disdain.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p7">10. His father rebuked him - Probably to lessen the
offense which his brethren would take at it; yet he took notice of it
more than he seemed to do.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p8">18. And when they saw him afar off they conspired against
him - It was not in a heat, or upon a sudden provocation, that they
thought to slay him, but from malice propense, and in cold blood.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p9">21. And Reuben heard it - God can raise up friends for
his people, even among their enemies. Reuben of all the brothers had
most reason to be jealous of Joseph, for he was the first-born, and so
entitled to those distinguishing favours which Jacob was conferring on
Joseph, yet he proves his best friend. Reuben's temper seems to have
been soft and effeminate, which had betrayed him to the sin of
uncleanness, while the temper of the two next brothers, Simeon and Levi,
was fierce, which betrayed them to the sin of murder, a sin which Reuben
startled at the thought of. He made a proposal which they thought would
effectually destroy Joseph, and yet which he designed should answer his
intention of rescuing Joseph out of their hands, probably hoping thereby
to recover his father's favour which he had lately lost; but God
over-ruled all to serve his own purpose of making Joseph an instrument
to save much people alive. Joseph was here a type of Christ. Though he
was the beloved Son of his Father, and hated by a wicked world; yet the
Father sent him out of his bosom to visit us; he came from heaven to
earth to seek and save us; yet then malicious plots were laid against
him; he came to his own, and his own not only received him not, but
consulted, This is the heir, come let us kill him. This he submitted to,
in pursuance of his design to save us.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p10">24. They call him into a pit - To perish there with
hunger and cold; so cruel were their tender mercies.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p11">25. They sat down to eat bread - They felt no remorse of
conscience, which if they had, would have spoiled their stomach to their
meat. A great force put upon conscience commonly stupifies it, and for
the time deprives it both of sense and speech.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p12">26. What profit is it if we slay our brother? - It will
be less guilt and more gain to sell him. They all agreed to this. And as
Joseph was sold by the contrivance of Judah for twenty pieces of silver,
so was our Lord Jesus for thirty, and by one of the same name too,
Judas. Reuben it seems, was gone away from his brethren when they sold
Joseph, intending to come round some other way to the pit, and to help
Joseph out of it. But had this taken effect, what had become of God's
purpose concerning his preferment, in Egypt? There are many devices of
the enemies of God's people to destroy them, and of their friends to
help them, which perhaps are both disappointed, as these here; but the
counsel of the Lord that shall stand. Reuben thought himself undone
because the child was sold; I, whither shall I go? He being the eldest,
his father would expect from him an account of him; but it proved they
had all been undone, if he had not been sold.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii-p13">35. He refused to be comforted - He resolved to go down
to the grave mourning; Great affection to any creature doth but prepare
for so much the greater affliction, when it is either removed from us,
or embittered to us: inordinate love commonly ends in immoderate
grief.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXVIII" progress="36.77%" prev="ii.ii.xxxviii.ii" next="ii.ii.xxxix.i" id="ii.ii.xxxix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXXVIII" id="ii.ii.xxxix-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|38|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.38" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xxxix-p0.2">XXXVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 38" progress="36.77%" prev="ii.ii.xxxix" next="ii.ii.xxxix.ii" id="ii.ii.xxxix.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxix.i-p1">How little reason had the Jews, who were so called from
this Judah, to boast, as they did, that they were not born of
fornication? <scripRef passage="John viii. 41" id="ii.ii.xxxix.i-p1.1" parsed="|John|8|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.8.41">John viii, 41</scripRef>. We have in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxix.i-p2">I. Judah's marriage and issue, and the
untimely death of his two eldest sons, ver. 1-11.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxix.i-p3">II. Judah's incest with his daughter-in-law
Tamar, ver. 12-23.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxix.i-p4">III. His confusion when it was discovered,
ver. 24-26.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xxxix.i-p5">IV. The birth of his twin sons in whom his
family was built up, ver. 27-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 38" progress="36.78%" prev="ii.ii.xxxix.i" next="ii.ii.xl" id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p1">1. Judah went down from his brethren -- withdrew for a
time from his father's family, and got intimately acquainted with one
Hirah an Adullamite. When young people that have been well educated
begin to change their company, they will soon change their manners, and
lose their good education. They that go down from their brethren, that
forsake the society of the seed of Israel, and pick up Canaanites for
their companions, are going down the hill apace.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p2">2. He took her-To wife. His father, it should seem, was
not consulted, but by his new friend Hirah.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p3">7. And Er was wicked in the sight of the Lord - That is,
in defiance of God and his law. And what came of it? Why God cut him off
presently, The Lord slew him. The next brother Onan was, according to
the ancient usage, married to the widow, to preserve the name of his
deceased brother that died childless. This custom of marrying the
brother's widow was afterward made one of the laws of Moses, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 5" id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Deut|25|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.5">Deut. xxv, 5</scripRef>. Onan, though he consented to marry the widow, yet to the
great abuse of his own body, of the wife he had married, and the memory
of his brother that was gone, he refused to raise up seed unto his
brother. Those sins that dishonour the body are very displeasing to God,
and the evidence of vile actions. Observe, the thing which he did
displeased the Lord - And it is to be feared, thousands, especially of
single persons, by this very thing, still displeased the Lord, and
destroy their own souls.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p4">11. Shelah the third son was reserved for the widow, yet
with design that he should not marry so young as his brothers had done,
lest he die also. Some think that Judah never intended to marry Shelah
to Tamar, but unjustly suspected her to have been the death of her two
former husbands, (whereas it was their own wickedness that slew them)
and then sent her to her father's house, with a charge to remain a
widow. If so, it was an inexcusable piece of prevarication; however
Tamar acquiesced, and waited for the issue.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p5">14. Some excuse this by suggesting that she believed the
promise made to Abraham and his seed, particularly that of the Messiah,
and that she was therefore desirous to have a child by one of that
family, that she might have the honour, or at least stand fair for the
honour of being the mother of the Messiah. She covered her with a veil -
It was the custom of harlots in those times to cover their faces, that
tho' they were not ashamed, yet they might seem to be so: the sin of
uncleanness did not then go so bare-faced as it now doth.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p6">17. A kid from the flock - A goodly price at which her
chastity and honour were valued! Had the consideration been thousands of
rams, and ten thousand rivers of oil, it had not been a valuable
consideration. The favour of God, the purity of the soul, the peace of
the conscience, and the hope of heaven: are too precious to be exposed
to sale at any such rates. He lost his Jewels by the bargain: He sent
the kid according to his promise, to redeem his pawn, but the supposed
harlot could not be found. He sent it by his friend, (who was indeed his
back-friend, because he was aiding and abetting in his evil deeds) the
Adullamite; who came back without the pledge. 'Tis a good account, if it
be but true, of any place that which they here gave, that there is no
harlot in this place, for such sinners are the scandals and plagues of
any place. Judah sits down content to lose his signet and his bracelets,
and forbids his friend to make any further enquiry.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p7">23. Lest we be shamed - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p8">1. Lest his sin should come to be known
publicly, Or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p9">2. Lest he should be laughed at as a fool
for trusting a whore with his signet and his bracelets. He expresses no
concern about the sin, only about the shame. There are many who are more
solicitous to preserve their reputation with men, than to secure the
savour of God, lest we be shamed goes farther with them than lest we be
damned.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p10">28. It should seem the birth was hard to the mother, by
which she was corrected for her sin: the children also, like Jacob and
Esau, struggled for the birth-right, and Pharez who got it, is ever
named first, and from him Christ descended. He had his name from his
breaking forth before his brother; this breach be upon thee - The Jews,
as Zarah, bid fair for the birth-right, and were marked with a scarlet
thread, as those that come out first; but the Gentiles, like Pharez, or
a son of violence got the start of them, by that violence which the
kingdom of heaven suffers, and attained to the righteousness which the
Jews came short of: yet when the fulness of time is come, all Israel
shall be saved. Both these sons are named in the genealogy of our
saviour, <scripRef passage="Matt. i. 3" id="ii.ii.xxxix.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Matt|1|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.1.3">Matt. i, 3</scripRef>, to perpetuate the story, as an instance of the humiliation
of our Lord Jesus.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIX" progress="36.86%" prev="ii.ii.xxxix.ii" next="ii.ii.xl.i" id="ii.ii.xl">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XXXIX" id="ii.ii.xl-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|39|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.39" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xl-p0.2">XXXIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 39" progress="36.86%" prev="ii.ii.xl" next="ii.ii.xl.ii" id="ii.ii.xl.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xl.i-p1">At this chapter we return to the story of Joseph. We have
him here,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xl.i-p2">I. A servant, a slave in Potiphar's house,
ver. 1. and yet there greatly honoured and favoured, (1.) By the
providence of God, which made him in effect a master, ver. 2-6. (2.) By
the grace of God, which made him more than conqueror over a strong
temptation, ver. 7-12.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xl.i-p3">II. We have him a sufferer, falsely
accused, ver. 13-18. Imprisoned, ver. 19, 20. And yet his imprisonment
made both honourable and comfortable by the tokens of God's special
presence with him, ver. 21-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 39" progress="36.87%" prev="ii.ii.xl.i" next="ii.ii.xli" id="ii.ii.xl.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p1">1. The Jews have a proverb, If the world did but know the
worth of good men, they would hedge them about with pearls. Joseph was
sold to an officer of Pharaoh, with whom he might get acquainted with
public persons, and public business, and so be fitted for the preferment
he was afterwards designed for. What God intends men for, he will be
sure, some way or other, to qualify them for.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p2">2. Those that can separate us from all our friends,
cannot deprive us of the gracious presence of our God. When Joseph had
none of his relations with him, he had his God with him, even in the
house of the Egyptian: Joseph was banished from his father's house, but
the Lord was with him. It is God's presence with us that makes all we do
prosperous. Those that would prosper, must therefore make God their
friend; and those that do prosper, must therefore give God the
praise.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p3">6. He knew not ought he had, save the bread which he did
eat - The servant had all the care and trouble of the estate, the master
had only the enjoyment of it; an example not to be imitated by any
master, unless he could be sure that he had one like Joseph for a
servant.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p4">9. How can I sin against God - Not only how shall I do it
and sin against my master, my mistress, myself, my own body and soul,
but against God? - Gracious souls look upon this as the worst thing in
sin, that it is against God, against his nature and his dominion,
against his love and his design. They that love God, for this reason
hate sin.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p5">10. He hearkened not to her, so much as to be with her.
Those that would be kept from harm, must keep themselves out of harm's
way.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p6">12. When she laid hold on him, he left his garment in her
hand - He would not stay to parley with the temptation, but flew out
from it with the utmost abhorrence, he left his garment as one escaping
for his life.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p7">20. Where the king's prisoners were bound - Potiphar, it
is likely, chose that prison because it was the worst; for there the
irons entered into the soul, <scripRef passage="Psalm cv. 18" id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Ps|105|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.105.18">Psalm cv,
18</scripRef>, but God designed it to pave the way to his enlargement. Our
Lord Jesus, like Joseph was bound, and numbered with the
transgressors.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p8">21. But the Lord was with Joseph and shewed him mercy.
God despiseth not his prisoners, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxix. 33" id="ii.ii.xl.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|69|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.69.33">Psalm lxix, 33</scripRef>. No gates nor bars can shut out his gracious presence from
his people. God gave him favour in the sight of the keeper of the prison
- God can raise up friends for his people even where they little expect
them. The keeper saw that God was with him, and that every thing
prospered under his hand, and therefore intrusted him with the
management of the affairs of the prison.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XL" progress="36.92%" prev="ii.ii.xl.ii" next="ii.ii.xli.i" id="ii.ii.xli">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XL" id="ii.ii.xli-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|40|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.40" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xli-p0.2">XL</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 40" progress="36.92%" prev="ii.ii.xli" next="ii.ii.xli.ii" id="ii.ii.xli.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xli.i-p1">In this chapter things are working towards Joseph's
advancement.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xli.i-p2">I. Two of Pharaoh's servants are committed
to prison, and there, to Joseph's care, and so became witnesses of his
extraordinary conduct, ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xli.i-p3">II. They dreamed each of them a dream,
which Joseph interpreted, ver. 5-19. and they verified the
interpretation, ver. 20-22.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xli.i-p4">III. Joseph recommends his case to one of
them whose preferment he foresaw, ver. 14, 15. but in vain, ver. 23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 40" progress="36.92%" prev="ii.ii.xli.i" next="ii.ii.xlii" id="ii.ii.xli.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xli.ii-p1">1. We should not have had this story of Pharaoh's butler
and baker recorded in scripture, if it had not been serviceable to
Joseph's preferment. The world stands for the sake of the church, and is
governed for its good. Observe,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xli.ii-p2">1. Two of the great officers of Pharaoh's
court having offended the king are committed to prison. Note, High
places are slippery places; nothing more uncertain than the favour of
princes. Those that make God's favour their happiness, and his service
their business, will find him a better master than Pharaoh was, and not
so extreme to mark what they do amiss. Many conjectures there are
concerning the offense of these servants of Pharaoh; some make it no
less than an attempt to take away his life; others no more but the
casual lighting of a fly into his cup, and a little sand in his bread:
whatever it was, Providence, by this means, brought them into the prison
where Joseph was.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xli.ii-p3">4. The captain of the guard, which was Potiphar, charged
Joseph with them - Which intimates that he began now to be reconciled to
him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xli.ii-p4">6. They were sad - It was not the prison that made them
sad; they were pretty well used to that, but the dream. God has more
ways than one to sadden the spirits of those that are to be made sad.
Those sinners that are hardy enough under outward trouble, yet God can
find a way to trouble them, and take off their wheels, by wounding their
spirits, and laying a load upon them.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xli.ii-p5">8. Do not interpretations belong to God? - He means the
God whom he worshipped, to the knowledge of whom he endeavours hereby to
lead them. And if interpretations belong to God, he is a free agent, and
may communicate the power to whom he pleases, therefore tell me your
dreams.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xli.ii-p6">14. Think on me, when it shall be well with thee - Though
the respect paid to Joseph, made the prison as easy to him as a prison
could be, yet none can blame him to be desirous of liberty. See what a
modest representation he makes of his own case. He doth not reflect upon
his brethren that sold him, only saith, I was stolen out of the land of
the Hebrews. Nor doth he reflect on the wrong done him in this
imprisonment by his mistress that was his persecutor, and his master
that was his judge, but mildly avers his own innocency. Here have I done
nothing that they should put me into the dungeon - When we are called to
vindicate ourselves, we should carefully avoid as much as may be
speaking ill of others. Let us be content to prove ourselves innocent,
and not fond of upbraiding others with their guilt.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xli.ii-p7">20. He lifted up the head of these two prisoners-That is,
arraigned and tried them; and he restored the chief butler, and hanged
the chief baker.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XLI" progress="36.97%" prev="ii.ii.xli.ii" next="ii.ii.xlii.i" id="ii.ii.xlii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XLI" id="ii.ii.xlii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|41|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.41" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xlii-p0.2">XLI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 41" progress="36.97%" prev="ii.ii.xlii" next="ii.ii.xlii.ii" id="ii.ii.xlii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xlii.i-p1">Two things providence is here bringing about.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlii.i-p2">1. The advancement of Joseph.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlii.i-p3">2. The maintenance of Jacob and his family
in a time of famine; for the eyes of the Lord run to and fro through the
earth, and direct the affairs of the children of men. In order to these,
here is,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xlii.i-p4">I. Pharaoh's dream, ver. 1-8.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xlii.i-p5">II. The recommendation of Joseph to him for
an interpreter, ver. 9-13.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xlii.i-p6">III. The interpretation of the dreams, and
the prediction of seven years plenty, and seven years famine in Egypt,
with the prudent advice given to Pharaoh thereupon, ver. 14-36.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xlii.i-p7">IV. The preferment of Joseph to a place of
the highest power and trust, ver. 37-45.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.ii.xlii.i-p8">V. The accomplishment of Joseph's
prediction, and his fidelity to his trust, ver. 46-57.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 41" progress="36.98%" prev="ii.ii.xlii.i" next="ii.ii.xliii" id="ii.ii.xlii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p1">8. His spirit was troubled - It cannot but put us into a
concern to receive any extraordinary message from heaven. And his
magicians were puzzled; the rules of their art failed them; these dreams
of Pharaoh did not fall within the compass of them. This was to make
Joseph's performance by the Spirit of God the more admirable.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p2">9. I remember my faults this day - in forgetting Joseph.
Some think he means his faults against Pharaoh, for which he was
imprisoned, and then he would insinuate, that through Pharaoh had
forgiven him, he had not forgiven himself. God's time for the
enlargement of his people will appear, at last, to be the fittest time.
If the chief butler had at first used his interest for Joseph's
enlargement, and had obtained, it is probable, he would have gone back
to the land of the Hebrews, and then he had neither been so blessed
himself, nor such a blessing to his family. But staying two years
longer, and coming out upon this occasion to interpret the king's
dreams, way was made for his preferment. The king can scarce allow him
time, but that decency required it, to shave himself, and to change his
raiment, chap. xli, 14. It is done with all possible expedition, and
Joseph is brought in perhaps almost as much surprised as Peter was, <scripRef passage="Acts xii. 9" id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Acts|12|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.12.9">Acts xii, 9</scripRef>, so suddenly is his captivity brought back, that he is as
one that dreams, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxvi. 1" id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Ps|76|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.76.1">Psalm lxxvi, 1.</scripRef> Pharaoh immediately, without enquiring who or whence he was
tells him his business, that he expected he should interpret his
dream.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p3">16.(1.) He gives honour to God; It is not in me; God must
give it. Great gifts then appear most graceful and illustrious, when
those that have them use them humbly, and take not the praise of them to
themselves, but give it to God, (2.) He shews respect to Pharaoh, and
hearty goodwill to him, supposing that the interpretation would be an
answer of peace. Those that consult God's oracles may expect an answer
of peace.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p4">29. See the goodness of God, in sending the seven years
of plenty before those of famine, that provision might be made
accordingly. How wonderful wisely has Providence, that great
house-keeper, ordered the affairs of this numerous family from the
beginning! Great variety of seasons there have been and the produce of
the earth sometimes more, and sometimes less; yet take one time with
another, what was miraculous concerning the manna, is ordinarily
verified in the common course of Providence; He that gathers much has
nothing over, and he that gathers little has no lack, <scripRef passage="Exod. xvi. 18" id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Exod|16|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16.18">Exod. xvi, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p5">30. See the perishing nature of our worldly enjoyments.
The great increase of the years of plenty was quite lost and swallowed
up in the years of famine; and the overplus of it, which seemed very
much, yet did but just serve to keep men alive.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p6">44. Without thee shall no man lift up his hand or foot -
All the affairs of the kingdom must pass through his hand. Only in the
throne will I be greater than thou - It is probable there were those
about court that opposed Joseph's preferment, which occasioned Pharaoh
so oft to repeat the grant, and with that solemn sanction, I am Pharaoh.
He gave him his own ring as a ratification of his commission, and in
token of peculiar favour; or it was like delivering him the great seal.
He put fine clothes upon him instead of his prison garments, and adorned
him with a chain of gold. He made him ride in the second chariot next
his own, and ordered all to do obeisance to him, as to Pharaoh himself;
he gave him a new name and such a name as spoke the value he had for
him, Zaphnath-paaneah, a Revealer of secrets. He married him honourably
to a prince's daughter. Where God had been liberal in giving wisdom and
other merits, Pharaoh was not sparing in conferring honours. Now this
preferment of Joseph, was, 1st, an abundant recompense for his innocent
and patient suffering, a lasting instance of the equity and goodness of
providence, and an encouragement to all to trust in a good God. 2ndly,
It was typical of the exaltation of Christ, that great revealer of
secrets, (<scripRef passage="John i. 18" id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|John|1|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.18">John i, 18</scripRef>,) or as some translate Joseph's new name, the saviour of the
world. The brightest glories of the upper world are upon him, the
highest trusts lodged in his hand, and all power given him both in
heaven and earth. He is gatherer, keeper, and disposer of all the stores
of divine grace, and chief ruler of the kingdom of God among men. The
work of ministers is to cry before him; Bow the knee; kiss the Son.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p7">50. Two sons - In the names he gave them, he owned the
divine Providence giving this happy turn to his affairs. He was made to
forget his misery, but could he be so unnatural as to forget all his
father's house? And he was made fruitful in the land of his affliction.
It had been the land of his affliction, and, in some sense, it was still
so, for his distance from his father was still his affliction. Ephraim
signifies fruitfulness, and Manasseh forgetfulness.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlii.ii-p8">54. The seven years of dearth began to come - Not only in
Egypt, but in other lands, in all lands, that is, all the neighbouring
countries.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XLII" progress="37.07%" prev="ii.ii.xlii.ii" next="ii.ii.xliii.i" id="ii.ii.xliii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XLII" id="ii.ii.xliii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|42|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.42" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xliii-p0.2">XLII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 42" progress="37.07%" prev="ii.ii.xliii" next="ii.ii.xliii.ii" id="ii.ii.xliii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xliii.i-p1">We have in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xliii.i-p2">I. The humble application of Jacob's sons
to Joseph, to buy corn, ver. 1-6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xliii.i-p3">II. The fright Joseph put them into, for
their trial, ver. 7-20.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xliii.i-p4">III. The conviction they were now under of
their sin concerning Joseph long before, ver. 21-24.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xliii.i-p5">IV. Their return to Canaan with corn, and
the great distress their good father was in upon the account they gave
him of their expedition, ver. 25-38.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 42" progress="37.08%" prev="ii.ii.xliii.i" next="ii.ii.xliv" id="ii.ii.xliii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p1">1. Jacob saw that there was corn - That is, he saw the
corn that his neighbours had bought there and brought home.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p2">2. Get you down thither - Masters of families must not
only pray for daily bread for their families, but must with care and
industry provide it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p3">7. We may well wonder that Joseph, during the twenty
years he had been in Egypt, especially during the last seven years that
he had been in power there, never sent to his father to acquaint him
with his circumstances; nay, 'tis strange that he who so oft went
throughout all the land of Egypt, never made a step to Canaan, to visit
his aged father. When he was in the borders of Egypt that lay next to
Canaan, perhaps it would not have been above three or four days journey
for him in his chariot. 'Tis a probable conjecture, that his whole
management of himself in this affair was by special direction from
heaven, that the purpose of God, concerning Jacob and his family, might
be accomplished. When Joseph's brethren came, he knew them by many a
good token, but they knew not him, little thinking to find him
there.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p4">9. He remembered the dreams, but they had forgot them.
The laying up of God's oracles in our hearts will be of excellent use to
us in all our conduct. Joseph had an eye to his dreams, which he knew to
be divine, in his carriage towards his brethren, and aimed at the
accomplishment of them, and the bringing his brethren to repentance; and
both those points were gained.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p5">1. He shewed himself harsh with them: the
very manner of his speaking, considering the post he was in, was enough
to frighten them, for he spake roughly to them - He charged them with
ill designs against the government, treated them as dangerous persons,
ye are spies, protesting by the life of Pharaoh that they were so. Some
make that an oath, others make it no more but a vehement asseveration;
however, it was more than yea, yea, and nay, nay, and therefore came of
evil.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p6">2. They hereupon were very submissive; they
spoke to him with all respect; nay, my Lord. They modestly deny the
charge, we are no spies; they tell him their business, they came to buy
food, they give a particular account of themselves and their family,
ver. 13, and that was it he wanted.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p7">3. He clapt them all up in prison three
days.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p8">4. He concluded with them at last, that one
of them should be left as a hostage, and the rest should go home and
fetch Benjamin. It was a very encouraging word he said, I fear God; q.d.
You may assure yourselves, I will do you no wrong, I dare not, for I
know that as high as I am, there is one higher than I. With those that
fear God we have reason to expect fair dealing: the fear of God will be
a check upon those that are in power, to restrain them from abusing
their power to oppression and tyranny:</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p9">21. We are very guilty concerning our brother - We do not
read that they said this during their three days imprisonment; but now
when the matter was come to some issue, and they saw themselves still
embarrassed, they began to relent. Perhaps Joseph's mention of the fear
of God, put them upon consideration, and extorted this reflexion.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p10">24. He took Simeon - He chose him for the hostage,
probably because he remembered him to have been his most bitter enemy,
or because he observed him now to be least humbled and concerned. He
bound him before their eyes, to affect them all.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p11">28. Their heart failed them, and they were afraid, saying
one to another, What is this that God hath done to us? - They knew that
the Egyptians abhorred a Hebrew, chap. xliii, 32, and therefore, since
they could not expect to receive any kindness from them, they concluded
that this was done with a design to pick a quarrel with them, the rather
because the man, the Lord of the land, had charged them as spies. Their
own conscience were awake, and their sins set in order before them, and
this puts them into confusion. When the events of providence concerning
us are surprising, it is good to inquire what it is that God has done
and is doing with us?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliii.ii-p12">38. My son shall not go down with you - He plainly
intimates a distrust of them, remembering that he never saw Joseph since
he had been with them; therefore Benjamin shall not go with you.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XLIII" progress="37.16%" prev="ii.ii.xliii.ii" next="ii.ii.xliv.i" id="ii.ii.xliv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XLIII" id="ii.ii.xliv-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|43|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.43" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xliv-p0.2">XLIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 43" progress="37.16%" prev="ii.ii.xliv" next="ii.ii.xliv.ii" id="ii.ii.xliv.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.i-p1">Here the story of Joseph's brethren is carried on.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xliv.i-p2">I. Their melancholy parting with their
father Jacob, in Canaan, ver. 1-14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xliv.i-p3">II. Their meeting with Joseph in Egypt,
ver. 15-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 43" progress="37.16%" prev="ii.ii.xliv.i" next="ii.ii.xlv" id="ii.ii.xliv.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.ii-p1">9. Judah's conscience had lately smitten him for what he
had done a great while ago against Joseph; and as an evidence of the
truth of his repentance, he is ready to undertake, as far as a man could
do it, for Benjamin's security. He will not only not wrong him but will
do all he can to protect him. This is such restitution as the case will
admit: when he knew not how he could retrieve Joseph, he would make some
amends for the irreparable injury he had done him, by doubling his care
concerning Benjamin.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.ii-p2">11. If it must be so now, take your brother - If no corn
can be had but upon those terms, as good expose him to the perils of the
journey, as suffer ourselves and families, and Benjamin among the rest,
to perish for want of bread: it is no fault, but our wisdom and duty, to
alter our resolutions when there is a good reason for so doing:
constancy is a virtue, but obstinacy is not: it is God's prerogative to
make unchangeable resolves.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.ii-p3">12. Take double money - As much again as they took the
time before, upon supposition that the price of corn might be risen, or
that, if it should be insisted upon, they might pay a ransom for Simeon.
And he sent a present of such things as the land afforded, and were
scarce in Egypt, the commodities that Canaan exported.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.ii-p4">14. God almighty give you mercy before the man! - Jacob
had formerly turned an angry brother into a kind one with a present and
a prayer, and here he betakes himself to the same tried method. Those
that would find mercy with men must seek it of God. He concludes all
with this, if I be bereaved of my children, I am bereaved - If I must
part with them thus one after another, I acquiesce and say, The will of
the Lord be done.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.ii-p5">23. Your God, and the God of your father, has given you
treasure in your sacks - Hereby he shews that he had no suspicion of
dishonesty in them: for what we get by deceit we cannot say God gives it
us. He silences their farther enquiry about it: ask not how it came
thither, providence brought it you, and let that satisfy you. It appears
by what he said, that by his master's instructions he was brought to the
knowledge of the true God, the God of the Hebrews. He directs them to
look up to God, and acknowledge his providence in the good bargain they
had. We must own ourselves indebted to God as our God, and the God of
our fathers, (a God in covenant with us and them) for all our successes
and advantages, and the kindnesses of our friends; for every creature is
that to us, and no more, than God makes it to be.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.ii-p6">26. When they brought him the present, they bowed
themselves before him, and again, when they gave him an account of their
father's health, they made obeisance, and called him, Thy servant, our
father - Thus were Joseph's dreams fulfilled more and more; and even the
father, by the sons, bowed before him. Probably Jacob had directed them,
if they had occasion to speak of him to the man, the Lord of the land,
to call him his servant.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.ii-p7">29. God be gracious unto thee, my son - Joseph's favour,
though he was the Lord of the land, would do him little good, unless God
were gracious to him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.ii-p8">33. He placed his brethren according to their seniority,
as if he could certainly divine. Some think they placed themselves so
according to their custom; but if so, I see not why such particular
notice is taken of it, especially as a thing they marvelled at.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xliv.ii-p9">34. They drank and were merry - Their cares and fears
were now over, and they eat their bread with joy, concluding they were
now upon good terms with the man, the Lord of the land. If God accept
our works, our present, we have reason to be chearful.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XLIV" progress="37.22%" prev="ii.ii.xliv.ii" next="ii.ii.xlv.i" id="ii.ii.xlv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XLIV" id="ii.ii.xlv-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|44|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.44" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xlv-p0.2">XLIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 44" progress="37.22%" prev="ii.ii.xlv" next="ii.ii.xlv.ii" id="ii.ii.xlv.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xlv.i-p1">Joseph having entertained his brethren, dismissed them:
but here we have them brought back in a greater fright than any they had
been in yet. Observe.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlv.i-p2">I. What method he took, both to humble them
farther, and to try their affections to his brother Benjamin, by which
he would be able to judge the sincerity of their repentance for what
they had done against him. This he contrived to do by bringing Benjamin
into distress, ver. 1-17.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlv.i-p3">II. The good success of the experiment: he
found them all heartily concerned, and Judah particularly, both for the
safety of Benjamin, and for the comfort of their aged father, ver.
18-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 44" progress="37.23%" prev="ii.ii.xlv.i" next="ii.ii.xlvi" id="ii.ii.xlv.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xlv.ii-p1">5. Is not this it in which my Lord drinketh? And for
which he would search thoroughly - So it may be rendered.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlv.ii-p2">16. God hath found out the iniquity of thy servants -
Referring to the injury they had formerly done to Joseph, for which they
thought God was now reckoning with them. Even in those afflictions
wherein we apprehend ourselves wronged by men, yet we must own that God
is righteous, and finds out our iniquity. We cannot judge what men are,
by what they have been formerly, not what they will do, by what they
have done. Age and experience may make men wiser and better, They that
had sold Joseph, yet would not abandon Benjamin.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlv.ii-p3">18. And Judah said - We have here a most pathetic speech
which Judah made to Joseph on Benjamin's behalf. Either Judah was a
better friend to Benjamin than the rest, and more solicitous to bring
him off; or he thought himself under greater obligations to endeavour it
than the rest, because he had passed his word to his father for his safe
return. His address, as it is here recorded, is so very natural, and so
expressive of his present passion, that we cannot but suppose Moses, who
wrote it so long after, to have written it under the special direction
of him that made man's mouth. A great deal of unaffected art, and
unstudied rhetoric there is in this speech.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlv.ii-p4">1. He addressed himself to Joseph with a
great deal of respect calls him his Lord, himself and his brethren his
servants, begs his patient hearing, and passeth a mighty compliment upon
him, Thou art even as Pharaoh, whose favour we desire, and whose wrath
we dread as we do Pharaoh's.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlv.ii-p5">2. He represented Benjamin as one well
worthy of his compassionate consideration, he was a little one, compared
with the rest; the youngest, not acquainted with the world, nor inured
to hardship, having been always brought up tenderly with his father. It
made the case the more piteous that he alone was left of his mother, and
his brother was dead, viz. Joseph; little did Judah think what a tender
point he touched upon now. Judah knew that Joseph was sold, and
therefore had reason enough to think that he was not alive.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlv.ii-p6">3. He urged it closely that Joseph had
himself constrained them to bring Benjamin with them, had expressed a
desire to see him, had forbidden them his presence, unless they brought
Benjamin with them, all which intimated, that he designed him some
kindness. And must he be brought with so much difficulty to the
preferment of a perpetual slavery? Was he not brought to Egypt in
obedience, purely in obedience to the command of Joseph, and would not
he shew him some mercy?</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlv.ii-p7">4. The great argument he insists upon was
the insupportable grief it would be to his aged father, if Benjamin
should be left behind in servitude. His father loves him, ver. 20. Thus
they had pleaded against Joseph's insisting on his coming down ver. 22.
If he should leave his father, his father would die, much more if he now
be left behind, never to return. This the old man of whom they spake,
had pleaded against his going down. If mischief befall him, ye shall
bring down my gray hairs, that crown of glory, with sorrow to the grave.
This therefore Judah presseth with a great deal of earnestness, his life
is bound up in the lad's life, when he sees that the lad is not with us,
he will faint away and die immediately, or will abandon himself to such
a degree of sorrow, as will, in a few days, make an end of him, And
(lastly) Judah pleads, that, for his part, he could not bear to see
this. Let me not see the evil that shall come on my father.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlv.ii-p8">5. Judah, in honour to the justice of
Joseph's sentence, and to shew his sincerity in this plea, offers
himself to become a bond- man instead of Benjamin. Thus the law would be
satisfied; Joseph would be no loser, for we may suppose Judah a more
able bodied man than Benjamin; Jacob would better bear that than the
loss of Benjamin. Now, so far was he from grieving at his father's
particular fondness for Benjamin, than he is himself willing to be a
bond-man to indulge it. Now, had Joseph been, as Judah supposed, an
utter stranger to the family, yet even common humanity could not but be
wrought upon by such powerful reasonings as these; for nothing could be
said more moving, more tender; it was enough to melt a heart of stone:
but to Joseph, who was nearer a-kin to Benjamin than Judah himself, and
who, at this time, felt a greater passion for him and his aged father,
than Judah did, nothing could be more pleasingly nor more happily said.
Neither Jacob nor Benjamin needed an intercessor with Joseph, for he
himself loved them. Upon the whole, let us take notice, (1.) How
prudently Judah suppressed all mention of the crime that was charged
upon Benjamin. Had he said any thing by way of acknowledgment of it, he
had reflected on Benjamin's honesty. Had he said any thing by way of
denial of it, he had reflected on Joseph's justice; therefore he wholly
waves that head, and appeals to Joseph's pity. (2.) What good reason
dying Jacob had to say, Judah, thou art he whom thy brethren shall
praise, chap. xlix, 8, for he excelled them all in boldness, wisdom,
eloquence, and especially tenderness for their father and family. (3.)
Judah's faithful adherence to Benjamin now in his distress was
recompensed long after, by the constant adherence of the tribe of
Benjamin to the tribe of Judah, when all the other ten tribes deserted
it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XLV" progress="37.33%" prev="ii.ii.xlv.ii" next="ii.ii.xlvi.i" id="ii.ii.xlvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XLV" id="ii.ii.xlvi-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|45|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.45" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xlvi-p0.2">XLV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 45" progress="37.33%" prev="ii.ii.xlvi" next="ii.ii.xlvi.ii" id="ii.ii.xlvi.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.i-p1">Joseph let Judah go on without interruption, heard all he
had to say, and then answered it all in one word, I am Joseph. Now he
found his brethren humbled for their sins, mindful of himself (for Judah
had mentioned him twice in his speech) respectful to their father, and
very tender of their brother Benjamin: now they were ripe for the
comfort he designed them, by making himself known to them. This was to
Joseph's brethren as clear shining after rain; nay, it was to them as
life from the dead. Here is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlvi.i-p2">I. Joseph's discovery of himself to his
brethren, and his discourse with them upon that occasion, ver. 1-15.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlvi.i-p3">II. The orders Pharaoh gave to fetch Jacob
and his family down to Egypt, and Joseph's dispatch of his brethren back
to his father with these orders, ver. 16-24.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlvi.i-p4">III. The joyful tidings of this brought to
Jacob, ver. 25-28.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 45" progress="37.34%" prev="ii.ii.xlvi.i" next="ii.ii.xlvii" id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p1">1. Judah and his brethren were waiting for an answer, and
could not but be amazed to discover, instead of the gravity of a judge,
the natural affection of a father or brother. Cause every man to go out
- The private conversations of friends are the most free. When Joseph
would put on love, he puts off state, which it was not fit his servants
should be witnesses of. Thus Christ graciously manifests himself and his
loving kindness to his people, out of the sight and hearing of the
world. See note at "ver. 2" for continuation to item</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p2">2. Tears were the introduction to his discourse. He had
dammed up this stream a great while, and with much ado, but now it
swelled so high that he could no longer contain, but he wept aloud, so
that those whom he had forbid to see him could not but hear him. These
were tears of tenderness and strong affection, and with these he threw
off that austerity, with which he had hitherto carried himself towards
his brethren; for he could bear it no longer. This represents the Divine
compassion towards returning penitents, as much as that of the father of
the prodigal, <scripRef passage="Luke xv. 20" id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Luke|15|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.15.20">Luke xv, 20</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Hosea xi. 8, 9" id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Hos|11|8|11|9" osisRef="Bible:Hos.11.8-Hos.11.9">Hosea xi,
8, 9</scripRef>. See note at "ver. 3" for continuation to item No. 3</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p3">3. He abruptly tells them; I am Joseph - They knew him
only by his Egyptian name, Zaphnath-paaneah, his Hebrew name being lost
and forgot in Egypt; but now he teaches them to call him by that, I am
Joseph: nay, that they might not suspect it was another of the same
name, he explains himself. I am Joseph your brother. This would both
humble them yet more for their sin in selling him, and encourage them to
hope for kind treatment. This word, at first, startled Joseph's
brethren, they started back through fear, or at least stood still
astonished: but Joseph called kindly and familiarly to them. Come near,
I pray you. Thus, when Christ manifests himself to his people he
encourages them to draw near to him with a true heart. Perhaps being
about to speak of their selling of him, he would not speak aloud, lest
the Egyptians should overhear, and it should make the Hebrews to be yet
more an abomination to them; therefore he would have them come near,
that he might whisper with them, which, now the tide of his passion was
a little over, he was able to do, whereas, at first, he could not but
cry out.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p4">4. He endeavours to sweep their grief for the injuries
they had done him, by shewing them, that, whatever they designed, God
meant it for good, and had brought much good out of it. See note at
"ver. 1" for start of item, ie. No. 1</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p5">5. Be not grieved or angry with yourselves - Sinners must
grieve, and be angry with themselves for their sins; yea, though God, by
his power, bring good out of them, for that is no thanks to the sinner:
but true penitents should be greatly affected with it, when they see God
bringing good out of evil. Though we must not with this consideration
extenuate our own sins, and so take off the edge of our repentance; yet
it may do well thus to extenuate the sins of others, and so take off the
edge of our angry resentments. Thus Joseph doth here. His brethren
needed not to fear that he would revenge upon them an injury which God's
providence had made to turn so much to his advantage, and that of his
family. Now he tells them how long the famine was likely to last, five
years yet, ver. 6, and what a capacity he was in of being kind to his
relations, which is the greatest satisfaction that wealth and power can
give to a good man.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p6">8. See what a favourable colour he puts upon the injury
they had done him, God sent me before you - God's Israel is the
particular care of God's providence. Joseph reckoned that his
advancement was not so much designed to save a whole kingdom of
Egyptians, as to preserve a small family of Israelites; for the Lord's
portion is his people: whatever goes with others, they shall be secured.
How admirable are the projects of Providence! How remote its tendencies!
What wheels are there within wheels; and yet all directed by the eyes in
the wheels, and the Spirit of the living Creature! See note at "ver. 1"
for start of item, ie. No. [1.] [5.] He promises to take care of his
father and all his family, during the rest of the years of famine. (1.)
He desires that his father might speedily be made glad with the tidings
of his life and honour. His brethren must hasten to Canaan, and acquaint
Jacob that his son Joseph was Lord of all Egypt - He knew it would be a
refreshing oil to his hoary head, and a sovereign cordial to his
spirits. He desires them to give themselves, and take with them to their
father, all possible satisfaction of the truth of these surprising
tidings.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p7">12. Your eyes see that it is my mouth - If they could
recollect themselves, they might remember something of his features and
speech, and be satisfied. See note at "ver. 1" for (2.) He is very
earnest that his father and all his family should come to him to Egypt.
Come down unto me, tarry not - He allots his dwelling in Goshen, that
part of Egypt which lay towards Canaan, that they might be mindful of
the country from which they were to come out. He promiseth to provide
for him, I will nourish - Our Lord Jesus being, like Joseph, exalted to
the highest honours and powers of the upper world, it is his will that
all that are his should be with him where he is. This is his
commandment, that we be with him now in faith and hope, and a heavenly
conversation; and this is his promise, that we shall be forever with
him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p8">24. See that ye fall not out by the way - He knew they
were but too apt to be quarrelsome; and what had lately passed, which
revived the remembrance of what they had done formerly against their
brother, might give them occasion to quarrel. Now Joseph having forgiven
them all, lays this obligation upon them, not to upbraid one another.
This charge our Lord Jesus has given to us, that we love one another,
that we live in peace, that whatever occurs, or whatever former
occurrences are remembered, we fall not out. For,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p9">1. We are brethren, we have all one
father.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p10">2. We are his brethren; and we shame, our
relation to him, who is our peace, if we fall out.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p11">3. We are all guilty, verily guilty, and
instead of quarrelling with one another, have a great deal of reason to
fall out with ourselves.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p12">4. We are forgiven of God, whom we have all
offended, and therefore should be ready to forgive one another.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p13">5. We are by the way, a way that lies
through the land of Egypt, where we have many eyes upon us, that seek
occasion and advantage against us; a way that leads to Canaan, where we
hope to be forever in perfect peace.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p14">26. We have here the good news brought to Jacob. When,
without any preamble, his sons came in crying Joseph is yet alive. The
very mention of Joseph's name revived his sorrow, so that his heart
fainted. It was a good while before he came to himself. He was in such
care and fear about the rest of them, that at this time it would have
been joy enough to him to hear that Simeon is released, and Benjamin is
come safe home; for he had been ready to despair concerning both these;
but to bear that Joseph is alive, is too good news to be true; he
faints, for he believes it not.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvi.ii-p15">27. When he saw the waggons his spirit revived - Now
Jacob is called Israel, for he begins to recover his wonted vigour. It
pleases him to think that Joseph is alive. He saith nothing of Joseph's
glory, which they had told him of; it was enough to him that Joseph was
alive: it pleases him to think of going to see him. Though he was old,
and the journey long, yet he would go to see Joseph, because Joseph's
business would not permit him to come to him. Observe, He will go see
him, not I will go live with him; Jacob was old, and did not expect to
live long: but I will go see him before I die, and then let me depart in
peace; let my eyes be refreshed with this sight before they are closed,
and then it is enough, I need no more to make me happy in this
world.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XLVI" progress="37.48%" prev="ii.ii.xlvi.ii" next="ii.ii.xlvii.i" id="ii.ii.xlvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XLVI" id="ii.ii.xlvii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|46|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.46" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xlvii-p0.2">XLVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 46" progress="37.48%" prev="ii.ii.xlvii" next="ii.ii.xlvii.ii" id="ii.ii.xlvii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xlvii.i-p1">Jacob is here removing to Egypt in his old age.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlvii.i-p2">I. God sends him thither, ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlvii.i-p3">II. All his family goes with him, ver.
5-27.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlvii.i-p4">III. Joseph bids him welcome, ver.
28-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 46" progress="37.49%" prev="ii.ii.xlvii.i" next="ii.ii.xlviii" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p1">1. And Israel came to Beer-sheba, and offered sacrifices
to the God of his father Isaac - He chose that place in remembrance of
the communion which his father and grandfather had with God in that
place. In his devotion he had an eye to God as the God of his father
Isaac, that is, a God in covenant with him, for by Isaac the covenant
was entailed upon him. He offered sacrifices, extraordinary sacrifices,
besides those at his stated times. These sacrifices were offered,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p2">1. By way of thanksgiving for the late
blessed change of the face of his family, for the good news he had
received concerning Joseph, and the hopes he had of seeing him.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p3">2. By way of petition for the presence of
God with him in his intended journey.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p4">3. By way of consultation. Jacob would not
go on 'till he had asked God's leave.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p5">2. And God spake unto Israel in the visions of the night
- (Probably the next night after he had offered his sacrifices.) Those
who desire to keep up communion with God, shall find that it never fails
on his side. If we speak to him as we ought, he will not fail to speak
to us. God called him by his name, by his old name, Jacob, Jacob, to
mind him of his low estate. Jacob, like one well acquainted with the
visions of the Almighty, answers, Here am I - Ready to receive orders.
And what has God to say to him?</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p6">3. I am God, the God of thy father - That is, I am what
thou ownest me to be: thou shalt find me a God of divine wisdom and
power engaged for thee: and thou shalt find me the God of thy father,
true to the covenant made with him. Fear not to go down into Egypt - It
seems though Jacob, upon the first intelligence of Joseph's life and
glory in Egypt, resolved without any hesitation I will go and see him,
yet upon second thoughts he saw difficulties in it.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p7">1. He was old, 130 years old; it was a long
journey, and he was unfit to travel.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p8">2. He feared lest his sons should be
tainted with the idolatry of Egypt, and forget the God of their
fathers.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p9">3. Probably he thought of what God had said
to Abraham concerning the bondage and affliction of his seed.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p10">4. He could not think of laying his bones
in Egypt. But whatever his discouragements were, this was enough to
answer them all, Fear not to go down into Egypt.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p11">4. I will go down with thee into Egypt - Those that go
where God sends them shall certainly have God with them. And I will
surely bring thee up again - Tho' Jacob died in Egypt, yet this promise
was fulfilled,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p12">1. In the bringing up of his body to be
buried in Canaan.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p13">2. In the bringing up of his seed to be
settled in Canaan. Whatever low and darksome valley we are called into,
we may be confident if God go down with us, he will surely bring us up
again. If he go with us down to death, he will surely bring us up again
to glory. And Joseph shall put his hand upon thine eyes - That is a
promise that Joseph should live as long as he lived, that he should be
with him at his death, and close his eyes with all possible tenderness.
Probably Jacob, in the multitude of his thoughts within him, had been
wishing that Joseph might do this last office of love for him; and God
thus answered him in the letter of his desire. Thus God sometimes
gratifies the innocent wishes of his people, and makes not only their
death happy, but the very circumstances of it agreeable.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p14">7. All his seed - 'Tis probable they continued to live
together in common with their father, and therefore when he went they
all went; which perhaps they were the more willing to do, because, tho'
they had heard that the land of Canaan was promised them, yet to this
day they had none of it in possession. We have here a particular account
of the names of Jacob's family; his sons sons, most of which are
afterwards mentioned, as heads of houses in the several tribes. See <scripRef passage="Num. xxvi. 5" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Num|26|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.26.5">Num. xxvi, 5</scripRef>, &amp;c. Issachar called his eldest son Tola, which
signifies a worm, probably because when he was born he was a little weak
child, not likely to live, and yet there sprang from him a very numerous
off-spring, <scripRef passage="1Ch vii. 2" id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p14.2" parsed="|1Chr|7|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.7.2">1Ch vii, 2</scripRef>. The whole number that went down into Egypt were sixty-six,
to which add Joseph and his two sons, who were there before, and Jacob
himself, the head of the family, and you have the number of seventy.
'Twas now 215 years since God had promised Abraham to make of him a
great nation, chap. xii, 2, and yet that branch of his seed, on which
the promise was entailed, was as yet increased but to seventy, of which
this particular account is kept, that the power of God in multiplying
these seventy to so vast a multitude, even in Egypt, may be the more
illustrious. When he pleases, A little one shall become a thousand.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlvii.ii-p15">30. Now let me die - Not but that it was farther
desirable to live with Joseph, and to see his honour and usefulness; but
he had so much satisfaction in this first meeting, that he thought it
too much to desire or expect any more in this world.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XLVII" progress="37.57%" prev="ii.ii.xlvii.ii" next="ii.ii.xlviii.i" id="ii.ii.xlviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XLVII" id="ii.ii.xlviii-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|47|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.47" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xlviii-p0.2">XLVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 47" progress="37.57%" prev="ii.ii.xlviii" next="ii.ii.xlviii.ii" id="ii.ii.xlviii.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xlviii.i-p1">In this chapter we have instances,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlviii.i-p2">I. Of Joseph's kindness to his relations,
presenting his brethren first, and then his father to Pharaoh, ver.
1-10. setting them in Goshen, and providing for them there, ver. 11, 12.
paying his respects to his father when he sent for him, ver. 27-31.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlviii.i-p3">II. Of Joseph's justice between prince and
people in a very critical affair; selling Pharaoh's corn to his subjects
with reasonable profit to Pharaoh, and yet without any wrong to them,
ver. 13-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 47" progress="37.58%" prev="ii.ii.xlviii.i" next="ii.ii.xlix" id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p1">3. What is your occupation? - Pharaoh takes it for
granted they had something to do. All that have a place in the world
should have an employment in it according to their capacity, some
occupation or other. Those that need not work for their bread, yet must
have something to do to keep them from idleness.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p2">4. To sojourn in the land are we cane - Not to settle
there forever; only to sojourn, while the famine prevailed so in
Canaan, which lay high, that it was not habitable for shepherds, the
grass being burnt up much more than in Egypt, which lay low, and where
the corn chiefly failed, but there was tolerable good pasture.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p3">8. How old art thou? - A question usually put to old men,
for it is natural to us to admire old age, and to reverence it. Jacob's
countenance no doubt shewed him to be old, for be had been a man of
labour and sorrow. In Egypt people were not so long-lived as in Canaan,
and therefore Pharaoh looks upon Jacob with wonder.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p4">9. Observe</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p5">1. Jacob calls his life a pilgrimage,
looking upon himself as a stranger in this world, and a traveler towards
another. He reckoned himself not only a pilgrim now he was in Egypt, a
strange country in which he never was before, but his life even in the
land of his nativity was a pilgrimage.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p6">2. He reckoned his life by days; for even
so it is soon reckoned, and we are not sure of the continuance of it for
a day to an end, but may be turned out of this tabernacle at less than
an hours warning.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p7">3. The character he gives of them was, (1.)
That they were few. Though he had now lived 130 years, they seemed to
him but as a few days, in comparison of the days of eternity, in which a
thousand years are but as one day; (2.) That they were evil. This is
true concerning man in general, <scripRef passage="Job xiv. 1" id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Job|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.14.1">Job xiv, 1</scripRef>, he is of few days and full of trouble: Jacob's life
particularly had been made up of evil days. the pleasantest days of his
life were yet before him. (3.) That they were short of the days of his
fathers; not so many, not so pleasant as their days. Old age came sooner
upon him than it had done upon some of his ancestors.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p8">10. And Jacob blessed Pharaoh - Which was not only an act
of civility but an act of piety; he prayed for him, as one having the
authority of a prophet and a patriarch: and a patriarch's blessing was
not a thing to be despised, no not by a potent prince.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p9">21. He removed them to cities - He transplanted them, to
shew Pharaoh's sovereign power over them, and that they might, in time,
forget their titles to their lands, and be the easier reconciled to
their new condition of servitude. How hard soever this seems to have
been upon them, they themselves were sensible of it as a great kindness,
and were thankful they were not worse used.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p10">28. Jacob lived seventeen years after he came into Egypt,
far beyond his own expectation: seventeen years he had nourished Joseph,
for so old he was when he was sold from him, and now, seventeen years
Joseph nourished him. Observe how kindly Providence ordered Jacob's
affairs; that when he was old, and least able to bear care and fatigue,
he had least occasion for it, being well provided for by his son without
his own forecast.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p11">29. And the time drew nigh that Israel must die - Israel,
that had power over the angel, and prevailed, yet must yield to death.
He died by degrees; his candle was not blown out, but gradually burnt
down, so that he saw, at some distance, the time drawing nigh. He would
be buried in Canaan, not because Canaan was the land of his nativity,
but in faith, because it was the land of promise, which he desired thus,
as it were to keep possession of 'till the time should come when his
posterity should be masters of it: and because it was a type of heaven,
that better country, which he was in expectation of. When this was done,
Israel bowed himself upon the bed's head - Worshipping God, as it is
explained, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 21" id="ii.ii.xlviii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Heb|11|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.21">Heb. xi, 21</scripRef>, giving God thanks for all his favours, and particularly for
this, that Joseph was ready, to put his hand upon his eyes. Thus they
that go down to the dust should, with humble thankfulness, bow before
God, the God of their mercies.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XLVIII" progress="37.65%" prev="ii.ii.xlviii.ii" next="ii.ii.xlix.i" id="ii.ii.xlix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XLVIII" id="ii.ii.xlix-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|48|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.48" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.xlix-p0.2">XLVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 48" progress="37.65%" prev="ii.ii.xlix" next="ii.ii.xlix.ii" id="ii.ii.xlix.i">

<p id="ii.ii.xlix.i-p1">In this chapter Jacob's dying words are recorded, because
he speaks by a spirit of prophecy; Abraham's and Isaac's are not. God's
gifts and graces shine forth much more in some than in others upon their
death-beds. Here is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlix.i-p2">I. Joseph hearing of his father's sickness
goes to visit him, and takes his two sons with him, ver. 1-2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlix.i-p3">II. Jacob solemnly adopts his two sons, and
takes them for his own, ver. 3-7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlix.i-p4">III. He blesseth them, ver. 8-16.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlix.i-p5">IV. He explains and justifies the crossing
of his hands in blessing them, ver. 17-20.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.xlix.i-p6">V. He leaves a particular legacy to Joseph,
ver. 21-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 48" progress="37.67%" prev="ii.ii.xlix.i" next="ii.ii.l" id="ii.ii.xlix.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p1">3. God blessed me - And let that blessing be entailed
upon them. God had promised him two things, a numerous issue, and Canaan
for an inheritance. And Joseph's sons, pursuant hereunto, should each of
them multiply into a tribe, and each of them have a distinct lot in
Canaan, equal with Jacob's own sons. See how he blessed them by faith in
that which God had said to him <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 21" id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Heb|11|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.21">Heb. xi, 21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p2">7. Mention is made of the death and burial of Rachel,
Joseph's mother, and Jacob's best beloved wife. The removal of dear
relations from us is an affliction, the remembrance of which cannot but
abide with us a great while. Strong affections in the enjoyment cause
long afflictions in the loss.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p3">11. I had not thought to see thy face, (having many years
given him up for lost) and lo God hath shewed me also thy seed? - See
here, How these two good men own God in their comforts. Joseph saith,
They are my sons whom God has given me - And to magnify the favour he
adds, in this place of my banishment, slavery and imprisonment. Jacob
saith here, God hath shewed me thy seed - Our comforts are then doubly
sweet to us, when we see them coming from God's hand.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p4">15. The God who fed me all my life long unto this day -
As long as we have lived in this world we have had continual experience
of God's goodness to us in providing for the support of our natural
life. Our bodies have called for daily food, and we have never wanted
food convenient. He that has fed us all our life long will not fail us
at last.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p5">16. The angel who redeemed me from all evil - A great
deal of hardship he had known in his time, but God had graciously kept
him from the evil of his troubles. Christ, the angel of the covenant is
he that redeems us from all evil. It becomes the servants of God, when
they are old and dying, to witness for our God that they have found him
gracious. Joseph had placed his children so, as that Jacob's right-hand
should be put on the head of Manasseh the eldest, ver. 12, 13, but Jacob
would put it on the head of Ephraim the youngest, ver. 14. This
displeased Joseph, who was willing to support the reputation of his
first-born and would therefore have removed his father's hands, ver. 17,
18, but Jacob gave him to understand that he knew what he did, and that
he did it neither by mistake nor in a humour, nor from a partial
affection to one more than the other, but from a spirit of prophecy.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p6">19. Ephraim shall he greater - When the tribes were
mustered in the wilderness Ephraim was more numerous than Manasseh, and
had the standard of that squadron, <scripRef passage="Num. i. 32, 33, 35" id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Num|1|32|1|33;|Num|1|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.1.32-Num.1.33 Bible:Num.1.35">Num. i, 32, 33, 35</scripRef>-ii, 18, 20, and is named first, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxx. 2" id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Ps|80|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.80.2">Psalm
lxxx, 2</scripRef>. Joshua was of that tribe. The tribe of Manasseh was
divided, one half on one side Jordan, the other half on the other side,
which made it the less powerful and considerable. God, in bestowing his
blessings upon his people, gives more to some than to others, more
gifts, graces and comforts, and more of the good things of this life.
And he often gives most to those that are least likely: he chuseth the
weak things of the world, raiseth the poor out of the dust. Grace
observes not the order of nature, nor doth God prefer those whom we
think fittest to be preferred but as it pleaseth him.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p7">21. I die, but God shall be with you, and bring you again
- This assurance was given them, and carefully preserved among them,
that they might neither love Egypt too much when it favoured them, nor
fear it too much when it frowned upon them. These words of Jacob furnish
us with comfort in reference to the death of our friends: But God shall
be with us, and his gracious presence is sufficient to make up the loss.
They leave us, but he will never fail us. He will bring us to the land
of our fathers, the heavenly Canaan, whither our godly fathers are gone
before us. If God be with us while we stay behind in this world, and
will receive us shortly to be with them that are gone before to a better
world, we ought not to sorrow as those that have no hope.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p8">22. He bestowed one portion upon him above his brethren.
The lands bequeathed are described to be those which he took out of the
hand of the Amorite with his sword and with his bow. He purchased them
first, <scripRef passage="Josh. xxiv. 32" id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Josh|24|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.24.32">Josh. xxiv,
32</scripRef>, and it seems was afterwards disseized of them by the
Amorites, but retook them by the sword, repelling force by force, and
recovering his right by violence when he could not otherwise recover it.
These lands he settled upon Joseph. Mention is made of this grant, <scripRef passage="John iv. 5" id="ii.ii.xlix.ii-p8.2" parsed="|John|4|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.4.5">John iv, 5</scripRef>. Pursuant to it, this parcel of ground was given to the
tribe of Ephraim as their right, and the lot was never cast upon it: and
in it Joseph's bones were buried, which perhaps Jacob had an eye to as
much as to any thing in this settlement. It may sometimes be both just
and prudent to give some children portions above the rest: but a grave
is that which we can most count upon as our own in this earth.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XLIX" progress="37.75%" prev="ii.ii.xlix.ii" next="ii.ii.l.i" id="ii.ii.l">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. XLIX" id="ii.ii.l-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|49|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.l-p0.2">XLIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 49" progress="37.75%" prev="ii.ii.l" next="ii.ii.l.ii" id="ii.ii.l.i">

<p id="ii.ii.l.i-p1">Jacob is here upon his death-bed making his will: what he
said here he could not say when he would, but as the Spirit gave him
utterance, who chose this time that divine strength might be perfected
in this weakness. The twelve sons of Jacob were in their day men of
renown; but the twelve tribes of Israel, which descended and were
denominated from them, were much more renowned, we find their names upon
the gates of the new Jerusalem, <scripRef passage="Rev. xxi. 12" id="ii.ii.l.i-p1.1" parsed="|Rev|21|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.21.12">Rev.
xxi, 12</scripRef>. In the prospect of which their dying father saith something
remarkable of each son, or of the tribe that bore his name. Here is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.l.i-p2">I. The preface, ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.l.i-p3">II. The prediction concerning each tribe,
ver. 3-28.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.l.i-p4">III. The charge repeated concerning his
burial, ver. 29-32.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.l.i-p5">IV. His death, ver. 33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 49" progress="37.76%" prev="ii.ii.l.i" next="ii.ii.li" id="ii.ii.l.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p1">1. Gather yourselves together - Let them all be sent for
to see their father die, and to hear his dying words. "Twas a comfort to
Jacob, now he was dying, to see all his children about him tho' he had
sometimes thought himself bereaved: 'twas of use to them to attend him
in his last moments, that they might learn of him how to die, as well as
how to live; what he said to each, he said in the hearing of all the
rest, for we may profit by the reproofs, counsels and comforts that are
principally intended for others. That I may tell you that which shall
befall you, not your persons but your posterity, in the latter days -
The prediction of which would be of use to those that come after them,
for confirming their faith, and guiding their way, at their return to
Canaan. We cannot tell our children what shall befall them, or their
families, in this world; but we can tell them from the word of God, what
will befall them in the last day of all, according as they carry
themselves in this world.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p2">2. Hearken to Israel your father - Let Israel that has
prevailed with God, prevail with you.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p3">3. Reuben thou art my first-born - Jacob here puts upon
him the ornaments of the birth-right, that he and all his brethren might
see what he had forfeited and in that might see the evil of his sin. As
the first-born he was his father's joy, being the beginning of his
strength. To him belonged the excellency of dignity above his brethren,
and some power over them.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p4">4. Thou shalt not excel - A being thou shalt have as a
tribe, but not an excellency. No judge, prophet, or prince, are found of
that tribe, nor any person of renown only Dathan and Abiram, who were
noted for their impious rebellion. That tribe, as not aiming to excel,
chose a settlement on the other side Jordan. The character fastened upon
Reuben, for which he is laid under this mark of infamy, is, that he was
unstable as water. His virtue was unstable, he had not the government of
himself, and his own appetites. His honour consequently was unstable, it
vanished into smoke, and became as water spilt upon the ground. Jacob
charges him particularly with the sin for which he was disgraced, thou
wentest up to thy father's bed - It was forty years ago that he had been
guilty of this sin, yet now it is remembered against him. Reuben's sin
left an indelible mark of infamy upon his family; a wound not to be
healed without a scar.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p5">5. Simeon and Levi are brethren -- brethren in
disposition, but unlike their father: they were passionate and
revengeful, fierce and wilful; their swords, that should have been only
weapons of defense, were (as the margin reads it) weapons of violence,
to do wrong to others, not to save themselves from wrong.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p6">6. They slew a man - Shechem himself, and many others;
and to effect that, they digged down a wall, broke the houses to plunder
them, and murder the inhabitants. O my soul, come not thou into their
secret - Hereby he professeth not only his abhorrence of such practices
in general, but his innocency particularly in that matter. Perhaps he
had been suspected as under-hand aiding and abetting; he therefore
solemnly expresseth his detestation of the fact.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p7">7. Cursed be their anger - Not their persons. We ought
always in the expressions of our zeal carefully to distinguish between
the sinner and the sin, so as not to love or bless the sin for the sake
of the person, nor to hate or curse the person for the sake of the sin.
I will divide them - The Levites were scattered throughout all the
tribes, and Simeon's lot lay not together, and was so strait that many
of that tribe were forced to disperse themselves in quest of settlements
and subsistence. This curse was afterwards turned into a blessing to the
Levites; but the Simeonites, for Zimri's sin, <scripRef passage="Num. xxv. 6-14" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Num|25|6|25|14" osisRef="Bible:Num.25.6-Num.25.14">Num. xxv, 6-14</scripRef>, had it bound on.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p8">8. Judah's name signifies praise, in allusion to which he
saith, Thou art he whom thy brethren shall praise, God was praised for
him, chap. xxix, 35, praised by him, and praised in him; and therefore
his brethren shall praise him. Thy hand shall be in the neck of thine
enemies - This was fulfilled in David, <scripRef passage="Psalm xviii. 40" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|18|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.18.40">Psalm xviii, 40</scripRef>. Thy father's children shall bow down before thee - Judah
was the law-giver, <scripRef passage="Psalm lx. 7" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p8.2" parsed="|Ps|60|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.60.7">Psalm lx, 7</scripRef>. That tribe led the van through the wilderness, and in the
conquest of Canaan, <scripRef passage="Jude i. 2" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p8.3" parsed="|Jude|1|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.1.2">Jude i, 2</scripRef>. The prerogatives of the birth-right which Reuben had
forfeited, the excellency of dignity and power, were thus conferred upon
Judah. Thy brethren shall bow down before thee, and yet shall praise
thee, reckoning themselves happy in having so wise and bold a
commander.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p9">9. Judah is a lion's whelp - The lion is the king of
beasts, the terror of the forest when he roars; when he seizeth his
prey, none can resist him; when he goes up from the prey, none dares
pursue him to revenge it. By this it is foretold that the tribe of Judah
should become very formidable, and should not only obtain great
victories but should peaceably enjoy what was got by those victories.
Judah is compared not to a lion rampant, always raging but to a lion
couching, enjoying the satisfaction of his success, without creating
vexation to others.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p10">10. The scepter shall not depart from Judah till Shiloh
come - Jacob here foretels, (1.) That the scepter should come into the
tribe of Judah, which was fulfilled in David, on whose family the crown
was entailed. (2.) That Shiloh should be of this tribe; that seed in
whom the earth should be blessed. That peaceable prosperous one, or, the
saviour, so others translate it, shall come of Judah. (3.) That the
scepter should continue in that tribe, till the coming of the Messiah,
in whom as the king of the church, and the great High-priest, it was fit
that both the priesthood and the royalty should determine. Till the
captivity, all along from David's time, the scepter was in Judah, and
from thence governors of that tribe, or of the Levites that adhered to
it, which was equivalent; till Judea became a province of the Roman
empire just at the time of our saviour's birth, and was at that time
taxed as one of the provinces, <scripRef passage="Luke ii. 1" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Luke|2|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.2.1">Luke ii,
1</scripRef>, and at the time of his death the Jews expressly owned, We
have no king but Caesar. Hence it is undeniably inferred against the
Jews, that our Lord Jesus is be that should come, and we are to look for
no other, for he came exactly at the time appointed. (4.) That it should
be a fruitful tribe, especially that it should abound with milk and
wine, ver. 11, 12, vines so common, and so strong, that they should tye
their asses to them, and so fruitful, that they should load their asses
from them; wine as plentiful as water, so that the men of that tribe
should be very healthful and lively, their eyes brisk and sparkling,
their teeth white. Much of that which is here said concerning Judah is
to be applied to our Lord Jesus.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p11">1. He is the ruler of all his Father's
children, and the conqueror of all his Father's enemies, and he it is
that is the praise of all the saints.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p12">2. He is the lion of the tribe of Judah, as
he is called with reference to this, <scripRef passage="Rev. v. 5" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Rev|5|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.5.5">Rev. v, 5</scripRef>, who having spoiled principalities and powers, went up a
conqueror, and couched so as none can stir him up when he sat down on
the right hand of the Father.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p13">3. To him belongs the scepter, he is the
lawgiver, and to him shall the gathering of the people be, as the desire
of all nations, <scripRef passage="Haggai ii. 7" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Hag|2|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hag.2.7">Haggai ii, 7</scripRef>, who being lifted up from the earth should draw all men unto
him, <scripRef passage="John xii. 32" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p13.2" parsed="|John|12|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.32">John xii,
32</scripRef>, and in whom the children of God that are scattered abroad
should meet as the center of their unity, <scripRef passage="John xi. 52" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p13.3" parsed="|John|11|52|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.11.52">John xi, 52</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p14">4. In him there is plenty of all that which
is nourishing and refreshing to the soul, and which maintains and chears
the divine life in it; in him we may have wine and milk, the riches of
Judah's tribe, without money, and without price, <scripRef passage="Isaiah lv. 1" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Isa|55|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.55.1">Isaiah lv, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p15">13. Zebulon shall dwell at the haven of the sea - This
was fulfilled, when 2 or 300 years after, the land of Canaan was divided
by lot, and the border of Zebulon went up towards the sea, <scripRef passage="Josh. xix. 11" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Josh|19|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.19.11">Josh. xix, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p16">14. Issachar is a strong ass, couching down between two
burdens - The men of that tribe shall be strong and industrious, fit for
and inclined to labour, particularly the toil of husbandry, like the ass
that patiently carries his burden. Issachar submitted to two burdens,
tillage and tribute.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p17">16. Daniel shall judge his people - Though Daniel was one
of the sons of the concubines, yet he shall be a tribe governed by
Judges of his own as well as other tribes; and shall by art and policy,
and surprise, gain advantages against his enemies, like a serpent
suddenly biting the heel of the traveler.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p18">18. I have waited for thy salvation, Lord - If he must
break off here, and his breath will not serve him to finish what he
intended, with these words he pours out his soul into the bosom of his
God, and even breaths it out. The pious ejaculations of a warm and
lively devotion, though sometimes they maybe incoherent, yet they are
not impertinent; that may be uttered affectionately, which doth not come
in methodically. It is no absurdity, when we are speaking to men, to
lift up our hearts to God. The salvation he waited for was, 1st, Christ,
the promised seed, whom he had spoken of, ver. 10, now he was going to
be gathered to his people, he breathes after him to whom the gathering
of the people shall be. 2ndly, Heaven, the better country, which he
declared plainly that he sought, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 13, 14" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Heb|11|13|11|14" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.13-Heb.11.14">Heb. xi, 13, 14</scripRef>, and continued seeking now he was in Egypt.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p19">19. Concerning Gad, he alludes to his name, which
signifies a troop, foresees the character of that tribe, that it should
be a warlike tribe; and so we find, <scripRef passage="1Ch xii. 8" id="ii.ii.l.ii-p19.1" parsed="|1Chr|12|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.12.8">1Ch
xii, 8</scripRef>, the Gadites were men of war fit for the battle. He
foresees, that the situation of that tribe on the other side Jordan
would expose it to the incursions of its neighbours, the Moabites and
Ammonites; and that they might not be proud of their strength and
valour, he foretells that the troops of their enemies should, in many
skirmishes, overcome them; yet, that they might not be discouraged by
their defeats, he assures them, that they should overcome at the last,
which was fulfilled, when in Saul's time and David's the Moabites and
Ammonites were wholly subdued.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p20">20. Concerning Asher, he foretells, That it should be a
rich tribe, replenished not only with bread for necessity, but with
fatness, with dainties, royal dainties, and these exported out of Asher,
to other tribes, perhaps to other lands. The God of nature has provided
for us not only necessaries but dainties, that we might call him a
bountiful benefactor; yet, whereas all places are competently furnished
with necessaries, only some places afford dainties. Corn is more common
than spices. Were the supports of luxury as universal as the supports of
life, the world would be worse than it is, and that needs not.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p21">21. Naphtali is a hind let loose - Those of this tribe
were, as the loosen'd hind, zealous for their liberty, and yet affable
and courteous, their language refined, and they complaisant, giving
goodly words. Among God's Israel there is to be found a great variety of
dispositions, yet all contributing to the beauty and strength of the
body. He closes with the blessings of his best beloved sons, Joseph and
Benjamin, with these he will breathe his last.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p22">22. Joseph is a fruitful bough, or young tree, for God
had made him fruitful in the land of his affliction, as branches of a
vine, or other spreading plant, running over the wall.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p23">23. The archer have sorely grieved him - Tho' he now
lived at ease and in honour, Jacob minds him of the difficulties he had
formerly waded through. He had many enemies here called archers, being
skilful to do mischief; they hated him, they shot their poisonous darts
at him. His brethren were spiteful towards him, mocked him, stripped
him, sold him, thought they had been the death of him. His mistress
sorely grieved him, and shot at him, when she solicited his chastity;
and then shot at him by her false accusations.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p24">24. But his bow abode in strength - His faith did not
fail; he kept his ground, and came off conqueror. The arms of his hands
were made strong - That is, his other graces did their part, his wisdom,
courage, patience, which are better than weapons of war: By the hands of
the mighty God - Who was therefore able to strengthen him; and the God
of Jacob, a God in covenant with him. From thence, from this strange
method of Providence, he became the shepherd and stone, the feeder and
supporter of Israel, Jacob and his family. Herein Joseph was a type of
Christ: He was shot at and hated, but born up under his sufferings, and
was afterwards advanced to be the shepherd and stone: and of the church
in general, hell shoots its arrows against her, but heaven protects and
strengthens her.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p25">25. Even by the God of thy father Jacob, who shall help
thee - Our experiences of God's power and goodness in strengthning us
hitherto, are encouragements still to hope for help from him. He that
has helped us, will. And by the Almighty, who shall bless thee; and he
only blesseth indeed. Observe the blessings conferred on Joseph; First,
Various and abundant blessings. Blessings of heaven above, rain in its
season, and fair weather in its season; blessings of the deep that lies
under this earth, or with subterraneous mines and springs. Blessings of
the womb and the breasts are given when children are safely born and
comfortably nursed. Secondly, Eminent and transcendent blessings, which
prevail above the blessings of my progenitors - His father Isaac had but
one blessing, and when he had given that to Jacob, he was at a loss for
a blessing to bestow upon Esau; but Jacob had a blessing for each of his
twelve sons, and now at the latter end, a copious one for Joseph.
Thirdly, Durable and extensive blessings: unto the utmost bound of the
everlasting hills - Including all the products of the most fruitful
hills, and lasting as long as they last. Of these blessings it is here
said they shall be, so it is a promise; or, let them be, so it is a
prayer, on the head of Joseph, to which let them be as a crown to adorn
it, and a helmet to protect it.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p26">27. Benjamin shall ravin as a wolf - It is plain, Jacob
was guided in what he said by a spirit of prophecy, and not by natural
affection, else he would have spoken with more tenderness of his beloved
son Benjamin, concerning whom he only foretells, that his posterity
should be a warlike tribe, strong and daring, and that they should
enrich themselves with the spoil of their enemies, that they should be
active in the world, and a tribe as much feared by their neighbours as
any other; in the morning he shall devour the prey which he seized and
divided over night.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p27">29. I am to be gathered unto my people - Though death
separate us from our children, and our people in this world, it gathers
us to our fathers, and to our people in the other world. Perhaps Jacob
useth this expression concerning death, as a reason why his sons should
bury him in Canaan, for (saith he) I am to be gathered unto my people,
my soul must be gone to the spirits of just men made perfect, and
therefore bury me with my fathers Abraham and Isaac, and their
wives.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.l.ii-p28">33. And when Jacob had made an end of commanding of his
sons - He addressed himself to his dying work. He put himself into a
posture for dying; having sat upon the bed-side to bless his sons, the
spirit of prophecy bringing fresh oil to his expiring lamp, when that
work was done, he gathered up his feet into the bed, that he might lie
along, not only as one patiently submitting to the stroke, but as one
cheerfully composing himself to rest. He then freely resigned his
spirits into the hand of God, the father of spirit; he yielded up the
ghost; and his separated soul went to the assembly of the souls of the
faithful, who after they are delivered from the burden of the flesh are
in joy and felicity; he was gathered to his people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="L" progress="38.04%" prev="ii.ii.l.ii" next="ii.ii.li.i" id="ii.ii.li">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Gen. L" id="ii.ii.li-p0.1" parsed="|Gen|50|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.50" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ii.li-p0.2">L</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter 50" progress="38.04%" prev="ii.ii.li" next="ii.ii.li.ii" id="ii.ii.li.i">

<p id="ii.ii.li.i-p1">Here, is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.li.i-p2">I. The preparation for Jacob's funeral,
ver. 1-6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.li.i-p3">II. The funeral itself, ver. 7-14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.li.i-p4">III. The settling of a good understanding
between Joseph and his brethren, after the death of Jacob, ver.
15-21.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ii.li.i-p5">IV. The age and death of Joseph, ver.
22-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter 50" progress="38.05%" prev="ii.ii.li.i" next="ii.iii" id="ii.ii.li.ii">

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p1">1. And Joseph fell upon his father's face and wept upon
him, and kissed him - Joseph shewed his faith in God, and love to his
father, by kissing his pale and cold lips, and so giving an affectionate
farewell. Probably the rest of Jacob's sons did the same, much moved, no
doubt, with his dying words.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p2">2. He ordered the body to be embalmed, not only because
he died in Egypt, and that was the manner of the Egyptians, but because
he was to be carried to Canaan, which would be a work of time.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p3">3. He observed the ceremony of solemn mourning for him.
Forty days were taken up in embalming the body, which the Egyptians had
an art of doing so curiously, as to preserve the very features of the
face unchanged. All this time, and thirty days more, seventy in all,
they either confined themselves and sat solitary, or when they went out,
appeared in the habit of close mourners, according to the decent custom
of the country. Even the Egyptians, many of them, out of the respect
they had for Joseph, put themselves into mourning for his father.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p4">5. He asked and obtained leave of Pharaoh to go to
Canaan, to attend the funeral of his father. It was a piece of necessary
respect to Pharaoh, that he would not go without leave; for we may
suppose, though his charge about the corn was long since over, yet he
continued a prime minister of state, and therefore would not be so long
absent from his business without license.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p5">11. The solemn mourning for Jacob gave a name to the
place; Abel-mizraim - The mourning of the Egyptians: which served for a
testimony against the next generation of the Egyptians, who oppressed
the posterity of this Jacob, to whom their ancestors shewed such
respect.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p6">15. Joseph will peradventure hate us - While their father
lived, they thought themselves safe under his shadow; but now he was
dead, they feared the worst. A guilty conscience exposeth men to
continual frights; those that would be fearless must keep themselves
guiltless.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p7">16. Thy father did command - Thus in humbling ourselves
to Christ by faith and repentance, we may plead that it is the command
of his father and our father we should do so.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p8">17. We are the servants of the God of thy father - Not
only children of the same Jacob, but worshippers of the same Jehovah.
Though we must be ready to forgive all that injure us, yet we must
especially take heed of bearing malice towards any that are the servants
of the God of our father; those we should always treat with a peculiar
tenderness, for we and they have the same master. He wept when they
spake to him - These were tears of sorrow for their suspicion of him,
and tears of tenderness upon their submission.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p9">19. Am I in the place of God? - He in his great humility
thought they shewed him too much respect, and faith to them in effect,
as Peter to Cornelius, Stand up, I myself also am a man. Make your peace
with God, and then you will find it an easy matter to make your peace
with me.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p10">20. Ye thought evil, but God meant it unto good - In
order to the making Joseph a greater blessing to his family than
otherwise he could have been.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p11">21. Fear not, I will nourish you - See what an excellent
spirit Joseph was of, and learn of him to render good for evil. He did
not tell them they were upon their good behaviour, and he would be kind
to them if he saw they carried themselves well: no, he would not thus
hold them in suspence, nor seem jealous of them, though they had been
suspicious of him. He comforted them, and, to banish all their fears, he
spake kindly to them. Those we love and forgive we must not only do well
for, but speak kindly to.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p12">24. I die, but God will surely visit you - To this
purpose Jacob had spoken to him, chap. xlviii, 21. Thus must we comfort
others with the same comforts wherewith we ourselves have been comforted
of God, and encourage them to rest on those promises which have been our
support. Joseph was, under God, both the protector and benefactor of his
brethren, and what would become of them now he was dying? Why let this
be their comfort, God will surely visit you. God's gracious visits will
serve to make up the loss of our best friends, and bring you out of this
land - And therefore, they must not hope to settle there, nor look upon
it as their rest forever; they must set their hearts upon the land of
promise, and call that their home.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p13">25. And ye shall carry up my bones from hence - Herein he
had an eye to the promise, chap. xv, 13, 14, and in God's name assures
them of the performance of it. In Egypt they buried their great men very
honourably, and with abundance of pomp; but Joseph prefers a plain
burial in Canaan, and that deferred almost two hundred years, before a
magnificent one in Egypt. Thus Joseph by faith in the doctrine of the
resurrection, and the promise of Canaan, gave commandment concerning his
bones, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 22" id="ii.ii.li.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Heb|11|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.22">Heb. xi,
22</scripRef>. He dies in Egypt; but lays his bones at stake, that God
will surely visit Israel, and bring them to Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.ii.li.ii-p14">26. He was put in a coffin in Egypt - But not buried till
his children had received their inheritance in Canaan, <scripRef passage="Josh. xxiv. 32" id="ii.ii.li.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Josh|24|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.24.32">Josh. xxiv, 32</scripRef>. If the soul do but return to its rest with God, the matter
is not great, though the deserted body find not at all, or not quickly,
its rest in the grave. Yet care ought to be taken of the dead bodies of
the saints, in the belief of their resurrection; for there is a covenant
with the dust which shall be remembered, and a commandment given
concerning the bones.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE SECOND BOOK OF MOSES CALLED EXODUS" progress="38.15%" prev="ii.ii.li.ii" next="ii.iii.i" id="ii.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod" id="ii.iii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.iii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE SECOND BOOK OF MOSES CALLED EXODUS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Exodus and Exodus I" progress="38.15%" prev="ii.iii" next="ii.iii.ii" id="ii.iii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.i-p1">MOSES having in the first book of his history preserved the
records of the church, while it existed in private families, comes, in
the second book, to give us an account of its growth into a great
nation. The beginning of the former book shews us how God formed the
world for himself, the beginning of this shews us how he formed Israel
for himself. There we have the creation of the world in history, here
the redemption of the world in type. The Greek translators called this
book Exodus, which signifies a going out, because it begins with the
story of the going out of the children of Israel from Egypt. This book
gives us,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.i-p2">I. The accomplishment of the promise made
before to Abraham, to chap. xix. and then,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.i-p3">II. The establishment of the ordinances which
were afterwards observed by Israel: thence to the end. Moses in this
book begins, like Caesar, to write his own commentaries; and gives us
the history of those things which he was himself an eye and ear witness
of. There are more types of Christ in this book than perhaps in any
other book of the Old Testament. The way of man's reconciliation to God,
and coming into covenant and communion with him by a Mediator, is here
variously represented; and it is of great use to us for the illustration
of the New Testament. We have here,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.i-p4">I. God's kindness to Israel, in multiplying
them exceedingly, ver. 1-7.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.i-p5">II. The Egyptians wickedness to them;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.i-p6">1. Oppressing and enslaving them, ver.
8-14.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.i-p7">2. Murdering their children, ver. 15-22.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="38.17%" prev="ii.iii.i" next="ii.iii.ii.i" id="ii.iii.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. I" id="ii.iii.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="38.17%" prev="ii.iii.ii" next="ii.iii.iii" id="ii.iii.ii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p1">1. Every man of his household - That is, children and
grand- children.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p2">3. And Benjamin - Who tho' youngest of all is placed
before Daniel, Naphtali, &amp;c. because they were the children of the
hand- maidens.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p3">5. Seventy souls - According to the computation we had, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlvi. 27" id="ii.iii.ii.i-p3.1" parsed="|Gen|46|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.46.27">Gen. xlvi, 27</scripRef>, including Joseph and his two sons. This was just the number
of the nations by which the earth was peopled, <scripRef passage="Gen. x. 1" id="ii.iii.ii.i-p3.2" parsed="|Gen|10|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.10.1">Gen. x,
1</scripRef>- 32, for when God separated the sons of Adam, he set the
bounds of the people according to the number of the children of Israel, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 8" id="ii.iii.ii.i-p3.3" parsed="|Deut|32|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.8">Deut. xxxii, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p4">6. All that generation by degrees wore off: perhaps all
Jacob's sons died much about the same time, for there was not past seven
years difference in age between the eldest and the youngest of them,
except Benjamin.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p5">7. And the children of Israel were fruitful, and
increased abundantly - Like fishes or insects, so that they multiplied;
and being generally healthful and strong, they waxed exceeding mighty,
so that the land was filled with them, at least Goshen, their own
allotment. This wonderful increase was the product of the promise long
before made to the fathers. From the call of Abraham, when God first
told him he would make him a great nation, to the deliverance of his
seed out of Egypt, was 430 years; during the first 215 of which, they
were increased to 70, but in the latter half, those 70 multiplied to
600, 000 fighting men.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p6">8. There arose a new king (after several successions in
Joseph's time) which knew not Joseph - All that knew him loved him, and
were kind to his relations for his sake; but when he was dead he was
soon forgotten, and the remembrance of the good offices he had done was
either not retained or not regarded. If we work for men only, our works
at farthest will die with us; if for God, they will follow us, <scripRef passage="Rev. xiv. 13" id="ii.iii.ii.i-p6.1" parsed="|Rev|14|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.14.13">Rev. xiv, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p7">10. Come on, let us deal wisely with them, lest they
multiply - When men deal wickedly it is common for them to imagine that
they deal wisely, but the folly of sin will at last be manifested before
all men.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p8">11. They set over them task-masters, to afflict them -
With this very design. They not only made them serve, which was
sufficient for Pharaoh's profit, but they made them serve with rigor, so
that their lives became bitter to them; intending hereby to break their
spirits, and to rob them of every thing in them that was generous: to
ruin their health, and shorten their days, and so diminish their
numbers: to discourage them from marrying, since their children would be
born to slavery; and to oblige them to desert the Hebrews, and
incorporate with the Egyptians. And 'tis to be feared the oppression
they were under did bring over many of them to join with the Egyptians
in their idolatrous worship; for we read, <scripRef passage="Josh. xxiv. 14" id="ii.iii.ii.i-p8.1" parsed="|Josh|24|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.24.14">Josh. xxiv, 14</scripRef>, that they served other gods in Egypt; and we find, <scripRef passage="Ezek. xx. 8" id="ii.iii.ii.i-p8.2" parsed="|Ezek|20|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.20.8">Ezek. xx, 8</scripRef>, that God had threatned to destroy them for it, even while
they were in the land of Egypt. Treasure-cities - To keep the king's
money or corn, wherein a great part of the riches of Egypt
consisted.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p9">12. But the more they afflicted them, the more they
multiplied - To the grief and vexation of the Egyptians. Times of
affliction, have oft been the church's growing times: Christianity
spread most when it was persecuted.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p10">15. And the king spake to the Hebrew midwives - The two
chief of them. They are called Hebrew midwives, probably not because
they were themselves Hebrews; for sure Pharaoh could never expect they
should be so barbarous to those of their own nation, but because they
were generally made use of by the Hebrews, and being Egyptians he hoped
to prevail with them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p11">16. The stools - Seats used on that occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p12">17. But the midwives feared God - Dreaded his wrath more
than Pharaoh's, and therefore saved the men-children alive.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p13">19. I see no reason we have to doubt the truth of this;
it is plain they were now under an extraordinary blessing of increase,
which may well be supposed to have this effect, that the women had quick
and easy labour, and the mothers and children being both lively, they
seldon needed the help of midwives; this these midwives took notice of,
and concluding it to be the finger of God, were thereby emboldened to
disobey the king, and with this justify themselves before Pharaoh, when
he called them to an account for it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ii.i-p14">20. Therefore God dealt well with them - That is, built
them up in families, and blessed their children.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="38.25%" prev="ii.iii.ii.i" next="ii.iii.iii.i" id="ii.iii.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. II" id="ii.iii.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="38.25%" prev="ii.iii.iii" next="ii.iii.iii.ii" id="ii.iii.iii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.iii.i-p1">This chapter begins the story of Moses, the most
remarkable type of Christ as prophet, saviour, law-giver, and mediator,
in all the Old Testament. In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.iii.i-p2">I. The perils of his birth and infancy,
ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.iii.i-p3">II. His preservation through those perils,
and the preferment of his childhood and youth, ver. 5-10.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.iii.i-p4">III. The pious choice of his riper years,
which was to own the people of God, (1.) He offered them his service, so
they would have accepted it, ver. 11-14. (2.) He retired, that he might
reserve himself for farther service, ver. 15-22.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.iii.i-p5">IV. The dawning of the day of Israel's
deliverance, ver. 23-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="38.26%" prev="ii.iii.iii.i" next="ii.iii.iv" id="ii.iii.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p1">1. And there went a man - Amram, from the place of his
abode to another place. A daughter - That is, grand-daughter of
Levi.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p2">2. Bare a son - It seems just at the time of his birth
that cruel law was made for the murder of all the male-children of the
Hebrews, and many no doubt perished by the execution of it. Moses's
parents had Miriam and Aaron, both elder than he, born to them before
that edict came out. Probably his mother had little joy of her being
with child of him, now this edict was in force. Yet this child proves
the glory of his father's house. Observe the beauty of providence: just
when Pharaoh's cruelty rose to this height, the deliverer was born. She
hid him three months - In some private apartment of their own house,
though probably with the hazard of their lives had he been discovered.
It is said, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 23" id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Heb|11|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.23">Heb. xi, 23</scripRef>. That Moses's parents hid him by faith: some think they had
a special Revelation that the deliverer should spring from their loins;
however, they believed the general promise of Israel's preservation, and
in that faith hid their child.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p3">3. And when she could no longer hide him, she put him in
an ark of bulrushes - By the river side. God put it into their hearts to
do this, to bring about his own purposes: that Moses might by this means
be brought into the hands of Pharaoh's daughter, and that by his
deliverance, a specimen might be given of the deliverance of God's
church.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p4">5. And the daughter of Pharaoh came - Providence brings
no less a person than Pharaoh's daughter just at that juncture, guides
her to the place where this poor infant lay, inclines her heart to pity
it, which she dares do, when none else durst. Never did poor child cry
so seasonably, as this did; the babe wept, which moved her compassion,
as no doubt his beauty did.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p5">10. And he became her son - The tradition of the Jews is,
that Pharaoh's daughter had no child of her own, and that she was the
only child of her father, so that when he was adopted for her son, he
stood fair for the crown: however, it is certain he stood fair for the
best preferments of the court in due time, and in the mean time had the
advantage of the best education, with the help of which, he became
master of all the lawful learning of the Egyptians <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 22" id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Acts|7|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.22">Acts vii, 22</scripRef>. Those whom God designs for great services he finds out ways
for to qualify them. Moses, by having his education in a court, is the
fitter to be a prince, and king in Jeshurun; by having his education in
a learned court, (for such the Egyptian then was) is the fitter to be an
historian; and by having his education in the court of Egypt, is the
fitter to be employed as an ambassador to that court in God's name. The
Jews tell us, that his father at his circumcision called him Joachim,
but Pharaoh's daughter called him Moses, Drawn out of the water, so it
signifies in the Egyptian language, The calling of the Jewish lawgiver
by an Egyptian name is a happy omen to the Gentile world, and gives
hopes of that day when it should be said, Blessed be Egypt my people, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xix. 25" id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p5.2" parsed="|Isa|19|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.19.25">Isaiah xix, 25</scripRef>. And his tuition at court was an earnest of the performance
of that promise, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xlix. 23" id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p5.3" parsed="|Isa|49|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.49.23">Isaiah xlix, 23</scripRef>. Kings shall be thy nursing fathers, and queens thy nursing
mothers.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p6">11. When Moses was grown he went out unto his brethren,
and looked on their burdens - He looked on their burdens as one that not
only pitied them, but was resolved to venture with them, and for
them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p7">12. He slew the Egyptian - Probably it was one of the
Egyptian task-masters, whom he found abusing his Hebrew slave. By
special warrant from heaven (which makes not a precedent in ordinary
cases) Moses slew the Egyptian, and rescued his oppressed brother. The
Jew's tradition is, that he did not slay him with any weapon, but as
Peter slew Ananias and Sapphira, with the word of his mouth.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p8">14. He said, Who made thee a prince? - He challengeth his
authority; Who made thee a prince? - A man needs no great authority for
giving a friendly reproof; it is an act of kindness; yet this man needs
will interpret it an act of dominion, and represents his reprover as
imperious and assuming. Thus, when people are sick of good discourse, or
a seasonable admonition, they will call it preaching, as if a man could
not speak a word for God, and against sin, but he took too much upon
him. Yet Moses was indeed a prince, and a judge, and knew it, and
thought the Hebrews would have understood it; but they stood in their
own light, and thrust him away. <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 25, 27" id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Acts|7|25|0|0;|Acts|7|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.25 Bible:Acts.7.27">Acts vii, 25, 27</scripRef>. Intendest thou to kill me? - See what base constructions
malice puts upon the best words and actions. Moses, for reproving him,
is presently charged with a design to kill him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p9">15. Moses fled from Pharaoh - God ordered this for wise
ends. Things were not yet ripe for Israel's deliverance. The measure of
Egypt's iniquity was not yet full; the Hebrews were not sufficiently
humbled, nor were they yet increased to such a multitude as God
designed: Moses is to be farther fitted for the service, and therefore
is directed to withdraw for the present, till the time to favour Israel,
even the set time, come. God guided Moses to Midian, because the
Midianites were of the seed of Abraham, and retained the worship of the
true God; so that he might have not only a safe, but a comfortable
settlement among them; and through this country he was afterwards to
lead Israel, which, that he might do the better, he now had opportunity
of acquainting himself with it. Hither he came, and sat down by a well;
tired and thoughtful, waiting to see which way Providence would direct
him. It was a great change with him, since he was but the other day at
ease in Pharaoh's court.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p10">17. Stood up and helped them - This be did, because
wherever he was, as occasion offered itself, he loved to be doing
justice, and appearing in the defense of such as he saw injured. He
loved to be doing good: wherever the Providence of God call us, we
should desire and endeavour to be useful; and when we cannot do the good
we would, we must be ready to do the good we can.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p11">18. Reul or Raguel (see <scripRef passage="Num. x. 29" id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Num|10|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.10.29">Num. x, 29</scripRef>,) seems to have been their grandfather and father of Hobab
or Jethro, their immediate father.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p12">22. Gershom - That is, A stranger there. Now this
settlement of Moses in Midian was designed by Providence. To shelter him
for the present; God will find hiding places for his people in the day
of their distress. It was also designed to prepare him for the services
he was farther designed to. His manner of life in Midian, where he kept
the flock of his father-in-law would be of use to him, to inure him to
hardship and poverty; and to inure him to contemplation and devotion.
Egypt accomplished him for a scholar, a gentleman, a statesman, a
soldier, all which accomplishments would be afterwards of use to him;
but yet lacketh he one thing, in which the court of Egypt could not
befriend him. He that was to do all by divine Revelation must know, what
it was to live a life of communion with God, and in this he would be
greatly furthered by the retirement of a shepherd's life in Midian. By
the former he was prepared to rule in Jeshurun, but by the latter he was
prepared to converse with God in Mount Horeb. Those that know what it is
to be alone with God, are acquainted with better delights than ever
Moses tasted in the court of Pharaoh.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p13">23. The king of Egypt died - And after him, one or two
more of his sons or successors. And the children of Israel sighed by
reason of bondage - Probably the murdering of their infants did not
continue, that part of their affliction only attended the birth of
Moses, to signalize that. And now they were content with their increase,
finding that Egypt was enriched by their labour; so they might have them
for their slaves, they cared not how many they were. On this therefore
they were intent, to keep them all at work, and make the best hand they
could of their labour. When one Pharaoh died, another rose up in his
place, that was as cruel to Israel as his predecessors. And they cried -
Now at last they began to think of God under their troubles, and to
return to him from the idols they had served, <scripRef passage="Ezek. xx. 8" id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Ezek|20|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.20.8">Ezek. xx, 8</scripRef>. Hitherto they had fretted at the instruments of their
trouble, but God was not in all their thoughts. But before God unbound
them, he put it into their hearts to cry unto him. It is a sign God is
coming towards us with deliverance, when he inclines us to cry to him
for it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iii.ii-p14">24. And God heard their groaning - That is, he made it to
appear that he took notice of their complaints. The groans of the
oppressed cry loud in the ears of the righteous God, to whom vengeance
belongs; especially the groans of God's children, the burdens they groan
under, and the blessings they groan after. And God remembered his
covenant - Which he seemed to have forgotten, but really is ever mindful
of. This God had an eye to, and not to any merit of theirs in what he
did for them. And God looked upon the children of Israel - Moses looked
upon them and pitied them, but now God looked upon them and helped them.
And God had respect unto them - A favourable respect to them as his own.
The frequent repetition of the name of God intimates, that now we are to
expect something great. His eyes which run to and fro through the earth,
are now fixed on Israel, to shew himself strong, to shew himself a God
in their behalf.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="38.43%" prev="ii.iii.iii.ii" next="ii.iii.iv.i" id="ii.iii.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. III" id="ii.iii.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="38.43%" prev="ii.iii.iv" next="ii.iii.iv.ii" id="ii.iii.iv.i">

<p id="ii.iii.iv.i-p1">In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.iv.i-p2">I. The discovery God was pleased to make of
his glory to Moses at the bush, ver. 1-5.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.iv.i-p3">II. A general declaration of God's goodwill
to his people, who were beloved for the Father's sake, ver. 6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.iv.i-p4">III. A particular notification of God's
purpose concerning the deliverance of Israel out of Egypt.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.iv.i-p5">1. He assures Moses it should now be done,
ver. 7-9.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.iv.i-p6">2. He gives him a commission to act in it
as his ambassador both to Pharaoh, ver. 10, and to Israel, ver. 16.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.iv.i-p7">3. He answers the objection Moses made of
his own unworthiness, ver. 11, 12.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.iv.i-p8">4. He gives him full instructions what to
say, both to Pharaoh and to Israel, ver. 13-18.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.iv.i-p9">5. He tells him before-hand what the issue
would be, ver. 14-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="38.44%" prev="ii.iii.iv.i" next="ii.iii.v" id="ii.iii.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p1">1. Now Moses - The years of Moses's life are remarkably
divided into three forties; the first forty he spent as a prince in
Pharaoh's court, the second a shepherd in Midian, the third a king in
Jeshurun. He had now finished his second forty when he received his
commission to bring Israel out of Egypt. Sometimes it is long before God
calls his servants out to that work which of old he designed them for.
Moses was born to be Israel's deliverer, and yet not a word is said of
it to him till he is eighty years of age. Even to Horeb - Horeb and
Sinai were two tops of the same mountain.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p2">2. And the angel of the Lord appeared to him - It was an
extraordinary manifestation of the divine glory; what was visible was
produced by the ministry of an angel, but he heard God in it speaking to
him. In a flame of fire - To shew that God was about to bring terror and
destruction to his enemies, light and heat to his people, and to display
his glory before all. And the bush burned, and yet was not consumed - An
emblem of the church now in bondage in Egypt, burning in the
brick-kilns, yet not consumed; cast down, but not destroyed.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p3">3. I will turn aside and see - He speaks as one
inquisitive, and bold in his inquiry; whatever it was, he would if
possible know the meaning of it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p4">4. When the Lord saw that he turned aside to see it, God
called to him - If he had carelessly neglected it, it is likely God had
departed and said nothing to him. God called and said, Moses, Moses -
This which he heard could not but surprise him much more than what he
saw. Divine calls are then effectual, when the spirit of God makes them
particular, and calls us as by name. The Word calls, Ho, every one; the
Spirit, by the application of that, calls, Ho, such a one; I know thee
by name. Here am I - Not only to hear what is said, but to do what I am
bidden.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p5">5. Put off thy shoes from off thy feet - The putting off
the shoe was then what the putting off the hat is now, a token of
respect and submission. The ground is holy ground, made so by this
special manifestation of the divine presence. We ought to approach to
God with a solemn pause and preparation; and to express our inward
reverence, by a grave and reverent behaviour in the worship of God,
carefully avoiding every thing that looks light, or rude.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p6">6. I am the God of thy father - He lets him know it is
God that speaks to him, to engage his reverence, faith and obedience.
Thy father, thy pious father Amram, and the God of Abraham, Isaac, and
Jacob, thy ancestors. Engaged to them by solemn covenant, which I am now
come to perform. And Moses hid his face, for he was afraid to look upon
God - The more we see of God, the more cause we shall see to worship him
with reverence and godly fear. And even the manifestations of God's
grace should increase our humble reverence of him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p7">8. I am come down to deliver them - When God doth
something very extraordinary, he is said to come down to do it, as <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxiv. 1" id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Isa|64|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.64.1">Isaiah lxiv, 1</scripRef>. This deliverance was typical of our redemption by Christ,
and in that the eternal Word did indeed come down from heaven to deliver
us. A large land - So it was, according to its true and ancient bounds,
as they are described, <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 18" id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Gen|15|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.18">Gen. xv, 18</scripRef>, and not according to those narrow limits, to which they
were afterwards confined for their unbelief and impiety. A land flowing
with milk and honey - A proverbial expression, abounding with the
choicest fruits, both for necessity and delight.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p8">10. I will send thee - And the same hand that now fetched
a shepherd out of a desert to be the planter of the Jewish church,
afterwards fetched fishermen from their ships to be the planters of the
Christian church, that the excellency of the power might be of God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p9">11. Who am I? - He thinks himself unworthy of the honour
and unable for the work. He thinks he wants courage, and therefore
cannot go to Pharaoh: he thinks he wants conduct, and therefore cannot
bring forth the children of Israel out of Egypt; they are unarmed,
undisciplined, quite dispirited, utterly unable to help themselves,
Moses was incomparably the fittest of any man living for this work,
eminent for learning, wisdom, experience, valour, faith, holiness, and
yet Who am I? The more fit any person is for service, commonly the less
opinion he has of himself.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p10">12. Certainly I will be with thee - Those that are weak
in themselves, yet may do wonders being strong in the Lord, and in the
power of his might. God's presence puts wisdom and strength into the
weak and foolish, and is enough to answer all objections.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p11">13. When they shall say to me, What is his name? What
shall I say unto them? - What name shall I use, whereby thou mayest be
distinguished from false gods, and thy people may be encouraged to
expect deliverance from thee?</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p12">14. And God said - Two names God would now be known
by.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p13">1. A name that speaks what he is in
himself, I am that I am - This explains his name Jehovah, and signifies,
1st, That he is self- existent; he has his being of himself, and has no
dependence upon any other. And being self-existent he cannot but be
self-sufficient, and therefore all-sufficient, and the inexhaustible
fountain of being and bliss. 2ndly, That he is eternal and unchangeable,
always the same, yesterday today, and forever: he will be what he will
be, and what he is. 3rdly. That he is faithful and true to all his
promises, unchangeable in his word as well as in his nature, and not a
man that he should lie. Let Israel know this, I am hath sent me unto
you.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p14">2. A name that speaks what he is to his
people. Lest that name I am should puzzle them, he is farther directed
to make use of another name of God, more familiar.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p15">15. The Lord God of our fathers hath sent me unto you -
Thus God made himself known, that he might revive among them the
religion of their fathers, which was much decayed, and almost lost. And
that he might raise their expectations of the speedy performance of the
promises made unto their fathers: Abraham, Isaac, and Jacob are
particularly named, because with Abraham the covenant was first made,
and with Isaac and Jacob oft expressly renewed, and these three were
distinguished from their brethren, and chosen to be the trustees of the
covenant. This God will have to be his name forever, and it has been,
is, and will be his name, by which his worshippers know him, and
distinguish him from all false gods.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p16">18. Hath met with us - Hath appeared to us, declaring his
will, that we should do what follows.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p17">19. I am sure he will not let you go - God sends his
messengers to those whose obstinacy he foresees, that it may appear he
would have them turn and live.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.iv.ii-p18">22. Everywoman shall ask (not borrow!) jewels. And I will
give this people favour in the sight of the Egyptians - God sometimes
makes the enemies of his people not only to be at peace with them, but
to be kind to them. And he has many ways of balancing accounts between
the injured and the injurious, of righting the oppressed, and compelling
those that have done wrong to make restitution.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="38.56%" prev="ii.iii.iv.ii" next="ii.iii.v.i" id="ii.iii.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. IV" id="ii.iii.v-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="38.56%" prev="ii.iii.v" next="ii.iii.v.ii" id="ii.iii.v.i">

<p id="ii.iii.v.i-p1">This chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.v.i-p2">I. Continues and concludes God's discourse
with Moses, concerning bringing Israel out of Egypt. [1.] Moses objects
the peoples unbelief, ver. 1. and God answers that objection by giving
him a power to work miracles: (1.) To turn his rod into a serpent, and
then into a rod again, ver. 2-5. (2.) To make his hand leprous, and then
whole again, ver. 6-8. (3.) To turn the water into blood, ver. 9.
[2.]Moses objects his own slowness of speech, ver. 10. and begs to be
excused, ver. 13. But God answers this objection, (1.) By promising him
his presence, ver. 11, 12. (2.) By joining Aaron in commission with him,
ver. 14-16. (3.) By putting an honour upon the very staff in his hand,
ver. 17.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.v.i-p3">II. Moses's execution of his commission.
(1.) He obtains leave of his father-in-law to return into Egypt, ver.
18. (2.) He receives further instructions from God, ver. 19, 21-23. (3.)
He hastens his departure, and takes his family with him, ver. 20. (4.)
He meets with some difficulty about the circumcising of his son, ver.
24. 26. (5.) He has the satisfaction of meeting his brother Aaron, ver.
27, 28. (6.) He produceth his commission before the elders of Israel, to
their great joy, ver. 29-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="38.58%" prev="ii.iii.v.i" next="ii.iii.vi" id="ii.iii.v.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p1">1. They will not hearken to my voice-That is, they would
not take his bare word, unless he shewed them some sign. He remembered
how they had once rejected him, and feared it would be so again.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p2">2. A rod - Or staff.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p3">5. That they may believe - An imperfect sentence to be
thus compleated, This thou shalt do, before them, that they may
believe.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p4">6. His hand was leprous, as snow - For whiteness. This
signified, That Moses, by the power of God, should bring sore diseases
upon Egypt, that at his prayer they should be removed. And that whereas
the Israelites in Egypt were become leprous, polluted by sin, and almost
consumed by oppression, by being taken into the bosom of Moses they
should be cleansed and cured.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p5">8. The voice of the first sign - God's works have a voice
to speak to us, which we must diligently observe.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p6">10. O my Lord, I am not eloquent - He was a great
philosopher, statesman, and divine, and yet no orator; a man of a clear
head, great thought and solid judgment, but had not a voluble tongue,
nor ready utterance; and therefore he thought himself unfit to speak
before great men, and about great affairs. Moses was mighty in word, <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 22" id="ii.iii.v.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Acts|7|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.22">Acts vii, 22</scripRef>, and yet not eloquent: what he said was strong and nervous,
and to the purpose, and distilled as the dew, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 2" id="ii.iii.v.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Deut|32|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.2">Deut. xxxii,
2</scripRef>, though he did not deliver himself with that readiness, ease
and fineness that some do.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p7">13. Send by whom thou wilt send - By any but me.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p8">14. And the anger of the Lord was kindled against him -
Even self-diffidence when it grows into an extreme, when it either
hinders us from duty, or clogs us in duty, is very displeasing to
him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p9">15. I will be with thy mouth and with his mouth - Even
Aaron that could speak well, yet could not speak to purpose, unless God
were with his mouth; without the constant aids of divine grace, the best
gifts will fail.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p10">16. Instead of God - To teach and to command him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p11">17. Take this rod - The staff or crook he carried as a
shepherd, that he might not be ashamed of that mean condition out of
which God called him. This rod must be his staff of authority, and must
be to him instead, both of sword and scepter.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p12">19. The Lord said unto Moses - This seems to have been a
second vision, whereby God calls him to the present execution of the
command given before.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p13">20. The rod of God - His shepherd's crook so called, as
it was God's instrument in so many glorious works.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p14">21. In thy hand - in thy power: I will harden his heart -
After he has frequently harden'd it himself, wilfully shutting his eyes
against the light, I will at last permit Satan to harden it
effectually.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p15">22. Thus saith the Lord - This is the first time that
preface is used by any man, which afterwards is used so frequently by
all the prophets: Israel is my son, my first-born - Precious in my
sight, honourable, and dear to me.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p16">23. Let my son go - Not only my servant whom thou hast no
right to detain, but my son whose liberty and honour I am jealous for.
If thou refuse, I will slay thy son, even thy first-born - As men deal
with God's people, let them expect to be themselves dealt with.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p17">24. It seems the sin of Moses, was neglecting to
circumcise his son, which perhaps was the effect of his being unequally
yoked with a Midianite, who was too indulgent of her child, and Moses so
of her. The Lord met him, and, probably, by a sword in an angel's hand,
sought to kill him - This was a great change. Very lately God was
conversing with him as a friend, and now coming forth against him as an
enemy. In this case of necessity Zipporah herself circumcised the child
without delay; whether with passionate words, expressing the dislike of
the ordinance itself, or at least the administration of it to so young a
child.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p18">26. So he let him go - The destroying angel withdrew. But
still Zipporah cannot forget, but will unreasonably call Moses a bloody
husband, because he obliged her to circumcise the child; and upon this
occasion, (it is probable) he sent them back to his father-in-law, that
they might not create him any further uneasiness. When we have any
special service to do for God, we should remove that as far from us as
we can, which is likely to be our hindrance: let the dead bury their
dead, but follow thou me.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p19">27. In the mount of God - That is, the place where God
had met with him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p20">28. Moses told Aaron all - Those that are fellow-servants
to God in the same work, should use a mutual freedom, and endeavour,
rightly and fully to understand one another.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.v.ii-p21">30. Aaron did the signs - By the direction of Moses.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="38.66%" prev="ii.iii.v.ii" next="ii.iii.vi.i" id="ii.iii.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. V" id="ii.iii.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="38.66%" prev="ii.iii.vi" next="ii.iii.vi.ii" id="ii.iii.vi.i">

<p id="ii.iii.vi.i-p1">Moses and Aaron here deal with Pharaoh to get leave of
him to go to worship in the wilderness.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.vi.i-p2">I. They demand leave in the name of God,
ver. 1. and he answers their demand with a defiance of God, ver. 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.vi.i-p3">II. They beg leave in the name of Israel,
ver. 3. and he answers their request with further orders to oppress
Israel, ver. 4-9. These cruel orders were,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.vi.i-p4">1. Executed by the task-masters, ver.
10-14.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.vi.i-p5">2. Complained of to Pharaoh, but in vain,
ver. 15-19.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.vi.i-p6">3. Complained of by the people to Moses,
ver. 20, 21. and by him to God, ver. 22, 23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="38.67%" prev="ii.iii.vi.i" next="ii.iii.vii" id="ii.iii.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p1">1. Thus saith the Lord God of Israel, Let my people go -
Moses, in treating with the elders of Israel, is directed to call God
the God of their fathers; but, in treating with Pharaoh, they call him
the God of Israel, and it is the first time we find him called so in
scripture. He is called the God of Israel, the person, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxiii. 20" id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|33|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.33.20">Gen. xxxiii, 20</scripRef>, but here it is Israel the people. They are just beginning
to be formed into a people when God is called their God. Let my people
go - They were God's people, and therefore Pharaoh ought not to detain
them in bondage. And he expected services and sacrifices from them, and
therefore they must have leave to go where they could freely exercise
their religion, without giving offense to, or receiving offense from,
the Egyptians.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p2">2. Who is the Lord that I should obey his voice? - Being
summoned to surrender, he thus hangs out the flag of defiance. Who is
Jehovah? I neither know him nor care for him; neither value nor fear
him. It is a hard name that he never heard of before, but he resolves it
shall be no bugbear to him. Israel was now a despised, oppressed people,
and by the character they bore he makes his estimate of their God, and
concludes that he made no better figure among the gods, than his people
did among the nations.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p3">3. We pray thee, let us go three days journey into the
desert - And that on a good errand, and unexceptionable: we will
sacrifice to the Lord our God - As other people do to theirs; lest if we
quite cast off his worship, he fall upon us - With one judgment or
other, and then Pharaoh will lose his vassals.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p4">5. The people are many - Therefore your injury to me is
the greater, in attempting to make them rest from their labours.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p5">6. The task-masters, were Egyptians, the officers were
Israelites employed under them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p6">7. Straw - To mix with the clay, or to burn the brick
with.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p7">8. They are idle - The cities they built for Pharaoh,
were witnesses for them that they were not idle; yet he thus basely
misrepresents them, that he might have a pretense to increase their
burdens.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p8">9. Vain words - Those of Moses and Aaron.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p9">14. In thy own people - For if they had given us straw,
we should have fulfilled our task.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p10">21. The Lord look upon you, and judge - They should have
humbled themselves before God, but instead of that they fly in the face
of their best friends. Those that are called to public service for God
and their generation, must expect to be tried not only by the threats of
proud enemies, but by the unjust and unkind censures of unthinking
friends. To put a sword in their hand to slay us - To give them the
occasion they have long sought for.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vi.ii-p11">22. He expostulated with him. He knew not how to
reconcile the providence with the promise, and the commission he had
received. Is this God's coming down to deliver Israel? Must I who hoped
to be a blessing to them become a scourge to them? By this attempt to
get them out of the pit, they are but sunk the farther into it.
Wherefore hast thou so evil entreated this people - Even when God is
coming towards his people in ways of mercy, yet sometimes he takes such
methods that they may think themselves but ill-treated: when they think
so, they should go to God by prayer, and that is the way to have better
treatment in God's good time. Why is it that thou hast sent me - Pharaoh
has done evil to this people, and not one step seems to be taken towards
their deliverance. It cannot but sit very heavy upon the spirits of
those whom God employs for him, to see that their labour doth no good,
and much more to see that it doth hurt, eventually, though not
designedly.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="38.74%" prev="ii.iii.vi.ii" next="ii.iii.vii.i" id="ii.iii.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. VI" id="ii.iii.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="38.74%" prev="ii.iii.vii" next="ii.iii.vii.ii" id="ii.iii.vii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.vii.i-p1">In this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.vii.i-p2">I. God satisfies Moses as to his
complaints, ver. 1.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.vii.i-p3">II. He gives him fuller instructions what
to say to the children of Israel, ver. 2-8. but to little purpose, ver.
9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.vii.i-p4">III. He sends him again to Pharaoh, ver.
10, 11. But Moses objects against that, ver. 12. upon which a strict
charge is given to him and his brother, to execute their commission with
vigour, ver. 13.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.vii.i-p5">IV. An abstract of the genealogy of the
tribes of Reuben and Simeon, to introduce that of Levi, that the
pedigree of Moses and Aaron might be cleared, ver. 14-27</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.vii.i-p6">V. A repetition of the preceding story,
ver. 28-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="38.75%" prev="ii.iii.vii.i" next="ii.iii.viii" id="ii.iii.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p1">1. With a strong hand - That is, being forced to it by a
strong hand, he shall let them go.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p2">2. I am Jehovah - The same with I am that I am, the
fountain of being and blessedness, and infinite perfection. The
patriarchs knew this name, but they did not know him in this matter by
that which this name signifies. God would now be known by his name
Jehovah, that is,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p3">1. A God performing what he had promised,
and so giving being to his promises.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p4">2. A God perfecting what he had begun, and
finishing his own work. In the history of the creation God is never
called Jehovah, till the heavens and the earth were finished, <scripRef passage="Gen. ii. 4" id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Gen|2|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.2.4">Gen. ii, 4</scripRef>. When the salvation of the saints is compleated in eternal
life, then he will be known by his name Jehovah, <scripRef passage="Rev. xxii. 13" id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p4.2" parsed="|Rev|22|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.22.13">Rev. xxii,
13</scripRef>, in the mean time they shall find him for their strength and
support, El-shaddai, a God All-sufficient, a God that is enough.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p5">5. I have heard the groaning of the children of Israel -
He means their groaning on occasion of the late hardships put upon them.
God takes notice of the increase of his people's calamities, and
observes how their enemies grow upon them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p6">6. I will bring you out: I will rid you: I will redeem
you: I will bring you into the land of Canaan; and, I will give it you -
Let man take the shame of his unbelief which needs such repetitions, and
let God have the glory of his condescending grace which gives us such
repeated assurances. With a stretched out arm - With almighty power: A
metaphor taken from a man that stretches out his arm, to put forth all
his strength.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p7">7. I will take you to me for a people - A peculiar
people, and I will be to you a God - And more than this we need not ask,
we cannot have, to make us happy.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p8">8. I am the Lord - And therefore have power to dispose of
lands and kingdoms as I please.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p9">9. But they hearkened not to Moses for anguish of spirit
- That is, They were so taken up with their troubles that they did not
heed him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p10">11. That he let the children of Israel go - God repeats
his precepts, before he begins his punishments. Those that have oft been
called in vain to leave their sins, yet must be called again, and
again.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p11">12. Behold, the children of Israel have not hearkened to
me; they gave no heed to what I have said, how then shall Pharaoh hear
me? - If the anguish of their spirit makes them deaf to that which would
compose and comfort them, much more will his pride and insolence, make
him deaf to that which will but exasperate him. Who am of uncircumcised
lips - He was conscious to himself that he had not the gift of
utterance.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p12">13. The Lord gave them a charge, both to the children of
Israel, and to Pharaoh - God's authority is sufficient to answer all
objections, and binds us to obedience without murmuring or
disputing.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p13">14. This genealogy ends in those two great patriots,
Moses and Aaron; and comes in here to shew that they were Israelites,
bone of their bone, and flesh of their flesh, whom they were sent to
deliver, raised up unto them of their brethren, as Christ also should
be, who was to be the prophet and priest, the Redeemer and law-giver of
the house of Israel, and whose genealogy also like this was to be
carefully preserved. The heads of the houses of three of the tribes are
here named, agreeing with the accounts we had, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlvi. 8-27" id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Gen|46|8|46|27" osisRef="Bible:Gen.46.8-Gen.46.27">Gen. xlvi, 8-27</scripRef>. Reuben and Simeon seem to be mentioned only for the sake of
Levi, from whom Moses and Aaron descended, and all the priests of the
Jewish church.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p14">16. The age of Levi, Kohath, and Amram, the father,
grandfather, and great grandfather of Moses is here recorded; and they
all lived to a great age, Levi to one hundred thirty seven, Kohath to
one hundred thirty three, and Amram to one hundred thirty seven: Moses
himself came much short of them, and fixed seventy or eighty for the
ordinary stretch of human life. <scripRef passage="Psalm xc. 10" id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Ps|90|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.90.10">Psalm
xc, 10</scripRef>. For now Israel was multiplied, and become a great nation,
and divine Revelation was by the hand of Moses committed to writing, and
no longer trusted to tradition; the two great reasons for the long lives
of the patriarchs were ceased, and therefore from henceforward fewer
years must serve men.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p15">20. His father's sister - That is, kins-woman. So the
Hebrew word is frequently used.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p16">23. Aminadab - A prince of the tribe of Judah. The
Levites might marry into any tribe, there being no danger of confusion
or loss of inheritance thereby.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p17">26. According to their armies - Like numerous armies, in
military order, and with great power. In the close of the chapter, he
returns to his narrative, from which he had broken off somewhat abruptly
ver. 13, and repeats, the charge God had given him to deliver his
message to Pharaoh, ver. 29.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.vii.ii-p18">29. Speak all that I say unto thee - As a faithful
ambassador. Those that go on God's errand must not shun to declare the
whole counsel of God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="38.83%" prev="ii.iii.vii.ii" next="ii.iii.viii.i" id="ii.iii.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. VII" id="ii.iii.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="38.83%" prev="ii.iii.viii" next="ii.iii.viii.ii" id="ii.iii.viii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.viii.i-p1">In this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.viii.i-p2">I. Moses applies himself to the execution
of his commission, ver. 1-7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.viii.i-p3">II. The dispute between Moses and Pharaoh
begins. Moses in God's name demands Israel's release, Pharaoh denies it;
the contest is between the power of the great God and the power of a
proud prince.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.viii.i-p4">1. Moses confirms the demand he made to
Pharaoh by a miracle, turning his rod into a serpent, but Pharaoh
hardens his heart, ver. 8-13.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.viii.i-p5">2. He chastiseth his disobedience by a
plague, the first of ten, turning the waters into blood; but Pharaoh
hardens his heart again, ver. 14-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="38.84%" prev="ii.iii.viii.i" next="ii.iii.ix" id="ii.iii.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p1">1. I have made thee a God to Pharaoh - That is, my
representative in this affair, as magistrates are called gods, because
they are God's vicegerents. He was authorized to speak and act in God's
name, and endued with a divine power, to do that which is above the
ordinary course of nature. And Aaron shall be thy prophet - That is, he
shall speak from thee to Pharaoh, as prophets do from God to the
children of men. Thou shalt as a God inflict and remove the plagues, and
Aaron as a prophet shall denounce them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p2">7. Moses was fourscore years old - Joseph, who was to be
only a servant to Pharaoh, was preferred at thirty years old; but Moses,
who was to be a God to Pharaoh, was not so dignified till he was eighty
years old. It is fit he should long wait for such an honour, and be long
in preparing for such a service.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p3">9. Say unto Aaron, Take thy rod - This Moses ordinarily
held in his hand, and delivered it to Aaron upon occasion, for the
execution of his commands.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p4">10. And Aaron cast his rod down, and it became a serpent
- This was proper not only to affect Pharaoh with wonder, but to strike
a terror upon him. This first miracle, though it was not a plague, yet
amounted to the threatening of a plague; if it made not Pharaoh feel, it
made him fear; this is God's method of dealing with sinners he comes
upon them gradually.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p5">11. Moses had been originally instructed in the learning
of the Egyptians, and was suspected to have improved in magical arts in
his long retirement. The magicians are therefore sent for to vie with
him. The two chief of them were Jannes and Jambres. Their rods became
serpents; probably by the power of evil angels artfully substituting
serpents in the room of the rods, God permitting the delusion to be
wrought for wise and holy ends. But the serpent which Aaron's rod was
turned into, swallowed up the others, which was sufficient to have
convinced Pharaoh on which side the right lay.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p6">13. And he harden'd Pharaoh's heart - That is, permitted
it to be hardened.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p7">20. The waters that were in the river were turned into
blood - This was a plague justly inflicted upon the Egyptians; for Nilus
the river of Egypt was their idol; they and their land had so much
benefit by that creature, that they served and worshipped it more than
the creator. Also they had stained the river with the blood of the
Hebrew children, and now God made that river all bloody; thus he gave
them blood to drink, for they were worthy, <scripRef passage="Rev. xvi. 6" id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Rev|16|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.16.6">Rev. xvi, 6</scripRef>. See the power of God. Every creature is that to us which he
makes it to be, water or blood. See the mutability of all things under
the sun, and what changes we may meet with in them. That which is water
to day may be blood to morrow; what is always vain may soon become
vexatious. And see what mischievous work sin makes! It is sin that turns
our waters into blood.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p8">22. And the magicians did so - By God's permission with
their enchantments; and this served Pharaoh for an excuse not to set his
heart to this also, (ver. 23,) and a poor excuse it was. Could they have
turned the river of blood into water again, it had been something; then
they had proved their power, and Pharaoh had been obliged to them as his
benefactors.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.viii.ii-p9">25. Seven days were fulfilled - Before this plague was
removed.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="38.90%" prev="ii.iii.viii.ii" next="ii.iii.ix.i" id="ii.iii.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. VIII" id="ii.iii.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="38.90%" prev="ii.iii.ix" next="ii.iii.ix.ii" id="ii.iii.ix.i">

<p id="ii.iii.ix.i-p1">Three more of the plagues of Egypt are related in this
chapter.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p2">I. That of the frogs, which is,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p3">1. Threatened, ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p4">2. Inflicted, ver. 5, 6.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p5">3. Mimicked by the magicians, ver. 7.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p6">4. Removed at the request of Pharaoh, ver.
8-14. who yet hardens his heart, and notwithstanding his promise, ver.
8. refused to let Israel go, ver. 15.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p7">II. The plague of lice, ver. 16, 17. By
which,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p8">1. The magicians were baffled, ver. 18, 19.
and yet,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p9">2. Pharaoh was hardened, ver. 19.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p10">III. That of flies:</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p11">1. Pharaoh is warned of it before, ver. 20,
21. and told that the land of Goshen should be exempt from this plague,
ver. 22, 23.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p12">2. The plague is brought, ver. 24.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p13">3. Pharaoh treats with Moses, and humbles
himself, ver. 25-29.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.ix.i-p14">4. The plague is thereupon removed, ver.
31. and Pharaoh's heart hardened, ver. 32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="38.91%" prev="ii.iii.ix.i" next="ii.iii.x" id="ii.iii.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p1">2. All thy borders - All the land that is within thy
borders.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p2">3. The River - Nile. Under which are comprehended all
other rivers and waters.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p3">9. Glory over me - That is, I yield to thee.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p4">10. And he said, Tomorrow - Why not immediately? Probably
he hoped that this night they would go away of themselves, and then he
should get clear of the plague, without being obliged either to God or
Moses. However, Moses joins issue with him upon it. Be it according to
thy word - It shall be done just when thou wouldst have it done, that
thou mayst know, that whatever the magicians pretend to, there is none
like unto the Lord our God - None has such a command as he has over all
creatures, nor is any so ready to forgive those that humble themselves
before him. The great design both of judgments and mercies, is to
convince us that there is none like the Lord our God; none so wise, so
mighty, so good; no enemy so formidable, no friend so desirable, so
valuable.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p5">15. But when Pharaoh saw that there was respite, he
hardened his heart - Observe he did it himself, not God, any otherwise
than by not hindering.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p6">17. The frogs were produced out of the waters, but the
lice out of the dust of the earth; for out of any part of the creation
God can fetch a scourge wherewith to correct those that rebel against
him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p7">18. And the magicians did so - That is, endeavoured to do
so.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p8">19. This is the finger of God - The power of God. The
devil's agents, when God permitted them, could do great things; but when
he laid an embargo upon them, they could do nothing. The magicians
inability in this instance shewed whence they had their ability in the
former instances, and that they had no power against Moses but what was
given them from above. But Pharaoh's heart was hardened - By himself and
the devil.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p9">20. Rise up early - Those that would bring great things
to pass for God and their generation must rise early, and redeem time in
the morning. Pharaoh was early up at his superstitious devotions to the
river; and shall we be for more sleep, and more slumber, when any
service is to be done which would pass well in our account in the great
day?</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p10">21. Flies - Or insects of various kinds; not only flies,
but gnats, wasps, hornets; and those probably more pernicious than the
common ones were.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p11">22. Know that I am the Lord in the midst of the earth -
In every part of it. Swarms of flies, which seem to us to fly at random,
shall be manifestly under the conduct of an intelligent mind. Hither
they shall go, saith Moses, and thither they shall come, and the
performance is punctual according to this appointment; and both compared
amount to a demonstration, that he that said it, and he that did it, was
the same, even a being of infinite power and wisdom.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p12">23. A division - A wall of partition.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p13">24. There came a grievous swarm of flies - The prince of
the power of the air has gloried in being Beel-zebub, the God of flies;
but here it is proved that even in that he is a pretender, and an
usurper; for even with swarms of flies God fights against his kingdom
and prevails.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p14">26. The abomination of the Egyptians - That which they
abominate to see killed, because they worshipped them as gods.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p15">27. As he shall command us - For he has not yet told us
what sacrifices to offer.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p16">28. Ye shall not go very far away - Not so far but that
he might fetch them back again. It is likely he suspected that if once
they left Egypt, they would never come back; and therefore when he is
forced to consent that they shall go, yet he is not willing they should
go out of his reach. See how ready God is to accept sinners submissions.
Pharaoh only says, Intreat for me - Moses promises immediately, I will
intreat the Lord for thee; and that he might see what the design of the
plague was, not to bring him to ruin, but to repentance.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.ix.ii-p17">32. But Pharaoh hardened his heart at this time also -
Still it is his own act and deed, not God's.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="38.98%" prev="ii.iii.ix.ii" next="ii.iii.x.i" id="ii.iii.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. IX" id="ii.iii.x-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="38.98%" prev="ii.iii.x" next="ii.iii.x.ii" id="ii.iii.x.i">

<p id="ii.iii.x.i-p1">In this chapter we have an account of three more
plagues.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.x.i-p2">I. Murrain among the cattle, ver. 1-7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.x.i-p3">II. Boils upon man and beast, ver.
8-12.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.x.i-p4">III. Hail, with thunder and lightning. (1.)
Warning is given of this plague, ver. 13-21. (2.) It is inflicted to
their great terror, ver 22-26. (3.) Pharaoh renews his treaty with
Moses, but instantly breaks his word, ver 27-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="38.99%" prev="ii.iii.x.i" next="ii.iii.xi" id="ii.iii.x.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p1">3. The hand of the Lord - Immediately, without the
stretching out of Aaron's hand, is upon the cattle, many of which, some
of all kinds, shall die by a sort of pestilence. The hand of God is to
be acknowledged even in the sickness and death of cattle, or other
damage sustained in them; for a sparrow falls not to the ground without
our father. And his providence is to be acknowledged with thankfulness
in the life of the cattle, for he preserveth man and beast, <scripRef passage="Psalm xxxvi. 6" id="ii.iii.x.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Ps|36|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.36.6">Psalm xxxvi, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p2">6. All the cattle died - All that were in the field. The
creature is made subject to vanity by the sin of man, being liable,
according to its capacity, both to serve his wickedness, and to share in
his punishment. The Egyptians worshipped their cattle; it was among them
that the Israelites learned to make a God of a calf; in that therefore
this plague meets with them. But not one of the cattle of the Israelites
died - Doth God take care for oxen? Yes, he doth, his providence extends
itself to the meanest of his creatures.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p3">9. A boil breaking forth with blains - A burning scab,
which quickly raised blisters and blains.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p4">10. Ashes of the furnace - Sometimes God shews men their
sin in their punishment: they had oppressed Israel in the furnaces, and
now the ashes of the furnace are made as much a terror to them as ever
their task-masters had been to the Israelites. This is afterwards called
the botch of Egypt, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxviii. 27" id="ii.iii.x.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Deut|28|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.28.27">Deut. xxviii,
27</scripRef>, as if it were some new disease, never heard of before, and
known ever after by that name.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p5">11. The magicians were forced to retreat, and could not
stand before Moses - To which the apostle refers, <scripRef passage="2 Tim. iii. 9" id="ii.iii.x.ii-p5.1" parsed="|2Tim|3|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Tim.3.9">2 Tim. iii, 9</scripRef>, when he saith, that their folly was manifested unto all
men.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p6">12. Now the Lord hardened Pharaoh's heart - Before he had
hardened his own heart, and resisted the grace of God, and now God
justly gave him up to his own heart's lusts, to strong delusions,
permitting Satan to blind and harden him. Wilful hardness is commonly
punished with judicial hardness. Let us dread this as the sorest
judgment a man can be under on this side hell.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p7">14. I will find all my plagues upon thy heart - Hitherto
thou hast not felt my plagues on thy own person, the heart is put for
the whole man.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p8">16. For this cause have I raised thee up - A most
dreadful message Moses is here ordered to deliver to him, whether he
will hear, or whether he will forbear. He must tell him, that he is
marked for ruin: that he now stands as the butt at which God would shoot
all the arrows of his wrath. For this cause have I raised thee up to the
throne at this time, and made thee to stand the shock of the plagues
hitherto, to shew in thee my power - Providence so ordered it, that
Moses should have a man of such a fierce and stubborn spirit to deal
with, to make it a most signal and memorable instance of the power God
has to bring down the proudest of his enemies; that my name,
irresistable power, and my inflexible justice, might be declared
throughout all the earth - Not only to all places, but through all ages
while the earth remains. This will be the event. But it by no means
follows, that this was the design of God. We have numberless instances
in scripture of this manner of speaking, to denote not the design, but
only the event.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p9">17. As yet exaltest thou thyself against my people - Wilt
thou not yet submit?</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p10">18. Since the foundation thereof - Since it was a
kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p11">29. The earth - The world, the heaven and the earth.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p12">30. Bolled - Grown up into a stalk.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.x.ii-p13">33. Moses went out of the city - Not only for privacy in
his communion with God, but to shew that he durst venture abroad into
the field, notwithstanding the hail and lightning, knowing that every
hail-stone had its direction from God. Peace with God makes men
thunder-proof, for it is the voice of their father. And spread abroad
his hands unto the Lord - An outward expression of earnest desire, and
humble expectation. He prevailed with God; but he could not prevail with
Pharaoh; he sinned yet more, and hardened his heart - The prayer of
Moses opened and shut heaven, like Elijah's. And such is the power of
God's two witnesses, <scripRef passage="Rev. xi. 6" id="ii.iii.x.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Rev|11|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.11.6">Rev. xi, 6</scripRef>. Yet neither Moses nor Elijah, nor those two witnesses,
could subdue the hard hearts of men. Pharaoh was frighted into
compliance by the judgment, but, when it was over, his convictions
vanished.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="39.07%" prev="ii.iii.x.ii" next="ii.iii.xi.i" id="ii.iii.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. X" id="ii.iii.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="39.07%" prev="ii.iii.xi" next="ii.iii.xi.ii" id="ii.iii.xi.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xi.i-p1">The eighth and ninth plagues are recorded in this
chapter.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xi.i-p2">I. Concerning the plague of locusts, (1.)
God instructs Moses in the meaning of these amazing dispensations of his
providence, ver. 1, 2. (2.) He threatens the locusts, ver. 3-6. (3.)
Pharaoh, at the persuasion of his servants, is willing to treat again
with Moses, ver. 7, 8, 9. but they cannot agree, ver. 10, 11, (4.) The
locusts come, ver. 12-15. (5.) Pharaoh cries for mercy, ver. 16, 17.
whereupon Moses prays for the removal of the plague, and it is done, but
Pharaoh's heart is still hardened, ver. 18-20.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xi.i-p3">II. Concerning the plague of darkness, (1.)
'Tis inflicted, ver. 21-23. (2.) Pharaoh again treats with Moses, but
the treaty breaks off, ver. 24-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="39.08%" prev="ii.iii.xi.i" next="ii.iii.xii" id="ii.iii.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p1">1. These plagues are standing monuments of the greatness
of God, the happiness of the church, and the sinfulness of sin; and
standing monitors to the children of men in all ages, not to provoke the
Lord to jealousy, nor to strive with their Maker. The benefit of these
instructions to the world doth sufficiently balance the expence.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p2">3. Thus saith the Lord God of the Hebrews, How long wilt
thou refuse to humble thyself before me? - It is justly expected from
the greatest of men, that they humble themselves before the great God,
and it is at their peril if they refuse to do it. Those that will not
humble themselves, God will humble.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p3">10. Let the Lord be so with you, as I will let you go,
and your little ones - He now curses and threatens them, in case they
offered to remove their little ones, telling them it was at their peril.
Satan doth all he can to hinder those that serve God themselves, from
bringing their children in to serve him. He is a sworn enemy to early
piety, knowing how destructive it is to the interests of his
kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p4">13. The east-wind brought the locusts - From Arabia,
where they are in great numbers: And God miraculously increased
them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p5">15. They covered the face of the earth, and eat up the
fruit of it - The earth God has given to the children of men; yet when
God pleaseth he can disturb his possession even by locusts or
caterpillars. Herb grows for the service of man; yet, when God pleaseth,
those contemptible insect's shall not only be fellow- commoners with
him, but shall eat the bread out of his mouth.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p6">17. Pharaoh desires their prayers that this death only
might be taken away, not this sin: he deprecates the plague of locusts,
not the plague of a hard heart.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p7">19. An east-wind brought the locusts and now a west-wind
carried them off. Whatever point of the compass the wind is in, it is
fulfilling God's word, and turns about by his counsel; the wind blows
where it listeth for us, but not where it listeth for him; he directeth
it under the whole heaven.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p8">21. We may observe concerning this plague.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p9">1. That it was a total darkness. We have
reason to think, not only that the lights of heaven were clouded, but
that all their fires and candles were put out by the damps or clammy
vapors which were the cause of this darkness, for it is said, they saw
not one another.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p10">2. That it was darkness which might be
felt, felt in its causes by their finger-ends, so thick were the fogs,
felt in its effects, (some think) by their eyes which were pricked with
pain, and made the more sore by their rubbing them. Great pain is spoken
of as the effect of that darkness, <scripRef passage="Rev. xvi. 10" id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Rev|16|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.16.10">Rev.
xvi, 10</scripRef>, which alludes to this.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p11">3. No doubt it was very frightful and
amazing. The tradition of the Jews is, that in this darkness they were
terrified by the apparition of evil spirits, or rather by dreadful
sounds and murmurs which they made; and this is the plague which some
think is intended (for otherwise it is not mentioned at all there) <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxviii. 49" id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Ps|78|49|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.78.49">Psalm lxxviii, 49</scripRef>. He poured upon them the fierceness of his anger, by sending
evil angels among them; for those to whom the devil has been a deceiver,
he will at length be a terror to.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p12">4. It continued three days; six nights in
one; so long they were imprisoned by those chains of darkness. No man
rose from his place - They were all confined to their houses; and such a
terror seized them, that few of them had the courage to go from the
chair to the bed, or from the bed to the chair. Thus were they silent in
darkness, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. ii. 9" id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p12.1" parsed="|1Sam|2|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.2.9">1 Sam. ii, 9</scripRef>. Now Pharaoh had time to consider, if he would have improved
it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p13">23. But the children of Israel had light in their
dwellings - Not only in the land of Goshen, where most of them
inhabited, but in the particular dwellings which in other places the
Israelites had dispersed among the Egyptians, as it appears they had by
the distinction afterwards appointed to be put on their door-posts. And
during these three days of darkness to the Egyptians, if God had so
pleased, the Israelites by the light which they had, might have made
their escape, and have asked Pharaoh no leave; but God would bring them
out with a high hand, and not by stealth or in haste.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xi.ii-p14">29. I will see thy face no more - Namely, after this
time, for this conference did not break off till chap. xi, 8, when Moses
went out in great anger and told Pharaoh how soon his proud stomach
would come down; which was fulfilled chap. xii, 31, when Pharaoh became
an humble supplicant to Moses to depart. So that after this interview
Moses came no more till he was sent for.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="39.16%" prev="ii.iii.xi.ii" next="ii.iii.xii.i" id="ii.iii.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XI" id="ii.iii.xii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="39.16%" prev="ii.iii.xii" next="ii.iii.xii.ii" id="ii.iii.xii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xii.i-p1">Pharaoh had bid Moses get out of his presence, chap. x,
28. and Moses had promised this should be the last time he would trouble
him, yet he refuses to say out what he had to say, before he left him.
Accordingly we have in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xii.i-p2">I. The instructions God had given to Moses,
which he was now to pursue, ver. 1, 2. together with the interest Israel
and Moses had in the esteem of the Egyptians, ver. 3.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xii.i-p3">II. The last message Moses delivered to
Pharaoh, concerning the death of the first-born, ver. 4-8.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xii.i-p4">III. A repetition of the prediction of
Pharaoh's hardening his heart, ver. 9. and the event answering it, ver.
10.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="39.17%" prev="ii.iii.xii.i" next="ii.iii.xiii" id="ii.iii.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xii.ii-p1">2. Let every man ask (not borrow!) of his neighbour
jewels - This was the last day of their servitude, when they were to go
away, and their masters, who had abused them in their work, would now
have defrauded them of their wages, and have sent them away empty, and
the poor Israelites were so fond of liberty that they themselves would
be satisfied with that, without pay: but he that executeth righteousness
and judgment for the oppressed, provided that the labourers should not
lose their hire. God ordered them to demand it now at their departure,
in jewels of silver, and jewels of gold; to prepare for which, God had
now made the Egyptians as willing to part with them upon any terms, as
before the Egyptians had made them willing to go upon any terms.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xii.ii-p2">5. The death of the first-born had been threatened, chap.
iv, 23, but is last executed, and less judgments tried, which, if they
had done the work, would have prevented this. See how slow God is to
wrath, and how willing to be met in the way of his judgments, and to
have his anger turned away! That sitteth upon his throne - That is to
set. The maid-servant behind the mill - The poor captive slave, employed
in the hardest labour.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xii.ii-p3">8. All these thy servants - Thy courtiers and great
officers: The people that follow thee - That are under thy conduct: and
command. When Moses had thus delivered his message, he went out from
Pharaoh in great anger, though he was the meekest of all the men of the
earth. Probably he expected that the very threatening of the death of
the first-born should have wrought upon Pharaoh to comply; especially he
having complied so far already, and having seen how exactly all Moses's
predictions were fulfilled. But it had not that effect; his proud heart
would not yield, no not to save all the first-born of his kingdom. Moses
hereupon was provoked to a holy indignation, being grieved, as our
saviour afterwards, for the hardness of his heart, <scripRef passage="Mark iii. 5" id="ii.iii.xii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Mark|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.3.5">Mark iii, 5</scripRef>.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="39.20%" prev="ii.iii.xii.ii" next="ii.iii.xiii.i" id="ii.iii.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XII" id="ii.iii.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="39.20%" prev="ii.iii.xiii" next="ii.iii.xiii.ii" id="ii.iii.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p1">This chapter gives an account of one of the most
memorable ordinances, and one of the most memorable providences of all
that art recorded in the old testament.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p2">I. None of all the ordinances of the Jewish
church were more eminent than that of the passover. It consisted of
three parts.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p3">1. The killing and eating of the paschal
lamb, ver. 1-6, 8-11.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p4">2. The sprinkling of the blood upon the
doorposts, peculiar to the first passover, ver. 7. with the reason for
it, ver. 11-13.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p5">3. The feast of unleavened bread for seven
days after; this points rather at what was to be done after in the
observance of this ordinance, ver. 14-20. This institution is
communicated to the people, and they instructed in the observance. (1.)
Of this first passover, ver. 21-23. (2.) Of the after passovers, ver.
24-27. And the Israelites obedience to these orders, ver. 28.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p6">II. None of all the providences of God
concerning the Jewish church was more illustrious, than the deliverance
of the children of Israel out of Egypt.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p7">1. The first-born of the Egyptians are
slain, ver. 29, 30.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p8">2. Orders are given immediately for their
discharge, ver. 31-33.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p9">3. They begin their march,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p10">1. Loaded with their own effects, ver.
34.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p11">2. Enriched with the spoils of Egypt, ver.
35, 36.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p12">3. Attended with a mixed multitude, ver.
37, 38,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p13">4. Put to their shifts for present supply,
ver. 39. This event is dated, ver. 40-42.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xiii.i-p14">III. A recapitulation in the close, 1st. Of
this memorable ordinance, with some additions, ver. 43-49; 2ndly. Of
this memorable providence, ver. 50, 51.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="39.23%" prev="ii.iii.xiii.i" next="ii.iii.xiv" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p1">1. The Lord spake - Had spoken, before the three days
darkness. But the mention of it was put off to this place, that the
history of the plagues might not be interrupted.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p2">2. This shall be to you the beginning of months - They
had hitherto begun their year from the middle of September, but
hence-forward they were to begin it from the middle of March, at least
in all their ecclesiastical computations. We may suppose that while
Moses was bringing the ten plagues upon the Egyptians, he was directing
the Israelites to prepare for their departure at an hour's warning.
Probably he had, by degrees, brought them near together from their
dispersions, for they are here called the congregation of Israel; and to
them, as a congregation, orders are here sent.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3">3. Take every man a lamb - In each of their families, or
two or three families, if they were small, join for a lamb. The lamb was
to be got ready four days before. and that afternoon they went, they
were to kill it, (ver. 6,) as a sacrifice, not strictly, for it was not
offered upon the altar, but as a religious ceremony, acknowledging God's
goodness to them, not only in preserving them from, but in delivering
them by the plagues inflicted on the Egyptians. The lamb so slain they
were to eat roasted (we may suppose in its several quarters) with
unleavened bread and bitter herbs; they were to eat it in haste, ver.
11, and to leave none of it until the morning; for God would have them
to depend upon him for their daily bread. Before they eat the flesh of
the lamb, they were to sprinkle the blood upon the door-posts; by which
their houses were to be distinguished from the houses of the Egyptians,
and so their first-born secured from the sword of the destroying angel.
Dreadful work was to be made this night in Egypt; all the first-born
both of man and beast were to be slain; and judgment executed upon the
gods of Egypt, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxiii. 4" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Num|33|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.33.4">Num. xxxiii,
4</scripRef>. It is probable the idols which the Egyptians worshipped
were defaced, those of metal melted, those of wood consumed, and those
of stone broke to pieces. This was to be annually observed as a feast of
the Lord in their generations, to which the feast of unleavened bread
was annexed, during which, for seven days, they were to eat no bread but
what was unleavened, in remembrance of their being confined to such
bread for many days after they came out of Egypt, ver. 14- 20. There was
much of the gospel in this ordinance: (1.) The paschal lamb was typical.
Christ is our passover, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. v. 7" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3.2" parsed="|1Cor|5|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.5.7">1 Cor. v, 7</scripRef>, and is the Lamb of God, <scripRef passage="John i. 29" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3.3" parsed="|John|1|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.1.29">John i, 29</scripRef>. 2. It was to be a male of the first year; in its prime.
Christ offered up himself in the midst of his days. It notes the
strength and sufficiency of the Lord Jesus, on whom our help was laid.
3. It was to be without blemish, noting the purity of the Lord Jesus, a
lamb without spot, <scripRef passage="1 Pet. i. 19" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3.4" parsed="|1Pet|1|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.1.19">1 Pet. i, 19</scripRef>. 4. It was to be set apart four days before, noting the
designation of the Lord Jesus to be a saviour, both in the purpose and
in the promise. It is observable, that as Christ was crucified at the
passover, so he solemnly entered into Jerusalem four days before, the
very day that the paschal lamb was set apart. 5. It was to be slain and
roasted with fire, noting the exquisite sufferings of the Lord Jesus,
even unto death, the death of the cross. 6. It was to be killed by the
whole congregation between the two evenings, that is, between three
o'clock and six. Christ suffered in the latter end of the world, <scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 26" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3.5" parsed="|Heb|9|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.26">Heb. ix, 26</scripRef>, by the hand of the Jews, the whole multitude of them, <scripRef passage="Luke xxiii. 18" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3.6" parsed="|Luke|23|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.23.18">Luke xxiii, 18</scripRef>. 7. Not a bone of it must be broken, ver. 46, which is
expressly said to be fulfilled in Christ, <scripRef passage="John xix. 33, 36" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3.7" parsed="|John|19|33|0|0;|John|19|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.19.33 Bible:John.19.36">John xix, 33,
36</scripRef>. (2.) The sprinkling of the blood was typical. 1st, It was
not enough that the blood of the lamb was shed, but it must be
sprinkled, noting the application of the merits of Christ's death to our
souls; 2ndly, It was to be sprinkled upon the door-posts, noting the
open profession we are to make of faith in Christ, and obedience to him.
The mark of the beast may be received in the forehead, or in the right
hand, but the seal of the lamb is always in the forehead, <scripRef passage="Rev. vii. 3" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3.8" parsed="|Rev|7|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.7.3">Rev. vii, 3</scripRef>. 3rdly, The blood thus sprinkled was a means of the
preservation of the Israelites from the destroying angel. If the blood
of Christ be sprinkled upon our consciences, it will be our protection
from the wrath of God, the curse of the law, and the damnation of hell.
(3.) The solemn eating of the lamb was typical of our gospel duty to
Christ. 1st, The paschal lamb was killed not to be looked upon only, but
to be fed upon; so we must by faith make Christ ours, as we do that
which we eat, and we must receive spiritual strength and nourishment
from him, as from our food, and have delight in him, as we have in
eating and drinking when we are hungry or thirsty. 2ndly, It was to be
all eaten: those that, by faith, feed upon Christ, must feed upon a
whole Christ. They must take Christ and his yoke, Christ and his cross,
as well as Christ and his crown. 3rdly, It was to be eaten with bitter
herbs, in remembrance of the bitterness of their bondage in Egypt; we
must feed upon Christ with brokenness of heart, in remembrance of sin.
4thly, It was to be eaten in a departing posture ver. 11, when we feed
upon Christ by faith, we must sit loose to the world, and every thing in
it. (4.) The feast of unleavened bread was typical of the Christian
life, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. v. 7, 8" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p3.9" parsed="|1Cor|5|7|5|8" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.5.7-1Cor.5.8">1 Cor.
v, 7, 8</scripRef>. Having received Christ Jesus the Lord, 1st. We must keep a
feast, in holy joy, continually delighting ourselves in Christ Jesus; If
true believers have not a continual feast, it is their own fault. 2ndly,
It must be a feast of unleavened bread, kept in charity, without the
leaven of malice, and in sincerity, without the leaven of hypocrisy. All
the old leaven of sin must be put far from us, with the utmost caution,
if we would keep the feast of a holy life to the honour of Christ.
3rdly, It was to be an ordinance forever. As long as we live we must
continue feeding upon Christ, and rejoicing in him always, with thankful
mention of the great things he has done for us.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p4">9. Raw - Half roasted, but throughly drest.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p5">10. Ye shall burn with fire - To prevent the profane
abuse of it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p6">11. The Lord's passover - A sign of his passing over you,
when he destroyed the Egyptians.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p7">16. An holy convocation - A solemn day for the people to
assemble together.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p8">19. A stranger - A proselyte. Heathens were not concerned
in the passover.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p9">22. Out of the door of his house - Of that house, wherein
he ate the passover: Until the morning - That is, till towards morning,
when they would be called for to march out of Egypt. They went out very
early in the morning.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p10">23. The destroyer - The destroying angel, whether this
was a good or an evil angel, we have not light to determine.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p11">27. The people bowed the head and worshipped - They
hereby signified their submission to this institution as a law, and
their thankfulness for it as a favour and privilege.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p12">31. Rise up, and get you forth - Pharaoh had told Moses
he should see his face no more, but now he sent for him; those will seek
God in their distress, who before had set him at defiance. Such a fright
he was now in that he gave orders by night for their discharge, fearing
lest if he delay'd, he himself should fall next. And that he sent them
out, not as men hated (as the Pagan historians have represented this
matter) but as men feared, is plain by his request to them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p13">32. Bless me also - Let me have your prayers, that I may
not be plagued for what is past when you are gone.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p14">33. We be all dead men - When death comes unto our
houses, it is seasonable for us to think of our own mortality.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p15">34. Their kneading-troughs - Or rather, their lumps of
paste unleavened.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p16">37. About six hundred thousand men - The word means
strong and able men fit for wars, beside women and children, which we
cannot suppose to make less than twelve hundred thousand more. What a
vast increase was this to arise from seventy souls, in little more than
two hundred years.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p17">38. And a mixed multitude went up with them - Some
perhaps willing to leave their country, because it was laid waste by the
plagues. But probably the greatest part was but a rude unthinking mob,
that followed they knew not why: It is likely, when they understood that
the children of Israel were to continue forty years in the wilderness,
they quitted them, and returned to Egypt again. And flocks and herds,
even very much cattle - This is taken notice of, because it was long ere
Pharaoh would give them leave to remove their effects, which were
chiefly cattle.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p18">39. Thrust out - By importunate entreaties.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p19">40. It was just four hundred and thirty years from the
promise made to Abraham (as the Apostle explains it, <scripRef passage="Gal. iii. 17" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Gal|3|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.3.17">Gal. iii, 17</scripRef>,) at his first coming into Canaan, during all which time the
Hebrews, were sojourners in a land that was not theirs, either Canaan or
Egypt. So long the promise God made to Abraham lay dormant and
unfulfilled, but now, it revived, and things began to work towards the
accomplishment of it. The first day of the march of Abraham's seed
towards Canaan was four hundred and thirty years (it should seem, to a
day) from the promise made to Abraham, <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 2" id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p19.2" parsed="|Gen|12|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.2">Gen. xii, 2</scripRef>. I will make of thee a great nation.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p20">42. This first passover night was a night of the Lord,
much to be observed; but the last passover night, in which Christ was
betrayed, was a night of the Lord, much more to be observed, when a yoke
heavier than that of Egypt was broke from off our necks, and a land
better than that of Canaan set before us. That was a temporal
deliverance, to be celebrated in their generations; this an eternal
redemption to be celebrated world without end.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p21">45. An hired servant - Unless he submit to be
circumcised.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p22">47. All the congregation of Israel must keep it - Though
it was observed in families apart, yet it is looked upon as the act of
the whole congregation. And so the new testament passover, the Lord's
supper, ought not to be neglected by any that are capable of celebrating
it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiii.ii-p23">48. No stranger that was uncircumcised might eat of it.
Neither may any now approach the Lord's supper who have not first
submitted to baptism; nor shall any partake of the benefit of Christ's
sacrifice, who are not first circumcised in heart. Any stranger that was
circumcised might eat of the passover, even servants. Here is an
indication of favour to the poor Gentiles, that the stranger, if
circumcised, stands upon the same level with the home-born Israelite;
one law for both. This was a mortification to the Jews, and taught them
that it was their dedication to God, not their descent from Abraham,
that entitled them to their privileges.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="39.42%" prev="ii.iii.xiii.ii" next="ii.iii.xiv.i" id="ii.iii.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XIII" id="ii.iii.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="39.42%" prev="ii.iii.xiv" next="ii.iii.xiv.ii" id="ii.iii.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.i-p1">In this chapter we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xiv.i-p2">I. The commands God gave to Israel,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiv.i-p3">1. To sanctify all their first-born to him,
ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiv.i-p4">2. To remember their deliverance out of
Egypt, ver. 3, 4. and in remembrance of it to keep the feast of
unleavened bread, ver. 5-8.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiv.i-p5">3. To transmit the knowledge of it to their
children, ver. 8-10.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiv.i-p6">4. To set apart to God the firstlings of
their cattle, ver. 11-13. and to explain that also to their children,
ver. 14-16.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xiv.i-p7">II. The care God took of Israel when he had
brought them out of Egypt.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiv.i-p8">1. Chusing their way for them, ver. 17,
18</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xiv.i-p9">2. Guiding them in the way, ver. 20-22. And
their care of Joseph's bones, ver. 19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="39.43%" prev="ii.iii.xiv.i" next="ii.iii.xv" id="ii.iii.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p1">2. Sanctify to me all the first-born - The parents were
not to look upon themselves as interested in their first-born, till they
had first solemnly presented them to God, and received them back from
him again. It is mine - By a special right, being by my singular favour
preserved from the common destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p2">5. When the Lord shall bring you into the land, thou
shalt keep this service - 'Till then they were not obliged to keep the
passover, without a particular command from God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p3">7. There shall no leavened bread be seen in all thy
quarters - Accordingly the Jews usage was, before the feast of the
passover, to cast all the leavened bread out of their houses; either
they burnt it, or buried it, or broke it small, and threw it into the
wind; they searched diligently with lighted candles in all the corners
of their houses, lest any leaven should remain. The strictness enjoined
in this matter was designed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p4">1. To make the feast the more solemn, and
consequently the more taken notice of by the children, who would ask,
why is so much ado made?</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p5">2. To teach us how solicitous we should be
to put away from us all sin.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p6">9. Upon thy hand, between thine eyes - Proverbial
expressions; denoting things which are never out of our thoughts.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p7">13. Thou shalt redeem - The price of the redemption was
fixed by the law.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p8">16. For frontlets between thine eyes - As conspicuous as
any thing fixt to thy forehead, or between thine eyes.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p9">18. There were many reasons why God led them through the
way of the wilderness of the red sea. The Egyptians were to be drowned
in the Red-sea, the Israelites were to be humbled, and proved in the
wilderness. <scripRef passage="Deut. viii. 2" id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Deut|8|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.8.2">Deut. viii, 2</scripRef>. God had given it to Moses for a sign, chap. iii, 12, ye
shall serve God in this mountain. They had again and again told Pharaoh
that they must go three days journey into the wilderness to do
sacrifice, and therefore it was requisite they should march that way,
else they had justly been exclaimed against as dissemblers. Before they
entered the lifts with their enemies, matters must be settled between
them and their God; laws must be given, ordinances instituted, covenants
sealed; and for the doing of this it was necessary they should retire
into the solitudes of a wilderness, the only closet for such a crowd;
the high road would be no proper place for these transactions. The
reason why God did not lead them the nearest way, which would have
brought them in a few days to the land of the Philistines, was because
they were not yet fit for war, much less for war with the Philistines.
Their spirits were broke with slavery; the Philistines were formidable
enemies; it was convenient they should begin with the Amalekites, and be
prepared for the wars of Canaan, by experiencing the difficulties of the
wilderness. God is said to bring Israel out of Egypt as the eagle brings
up her young ones, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 11" id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p9.2" parsed="|Deut|32|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.11">Deut. xxxii, 11</scripRef>, teaching them by degrees to fly. They went up harnessed -
They went up by five in a rank, so some; in five squadrons, so others.
They marched like an army with banners, which added much to strength and
honour.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p10">21. And the Lord went before them in a pillar - In the
two first stages, it was enough that God directed Moses whither to
march; he knew the country, and the road; but now they are come to the
edge of the wilderness, they would have occasion for a guide, and a very
good guide they had, infinitely wise, kind, and faithful, the Lord went
up before them; The Shechinah or appearance of the divine Majesty, which
was a precious manifestation of the eternal Word, who in the fulness of
time was to be made flesh, and dwell among us. Christ was with the
church in the wilderness, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. x. 9" id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p10.1" parsed="|1Cor|10|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10.9">1 Cor. x, 9</scripRef>. What a satisfaction to Moses and the pious Israelites, to
be sure that they were under a divine conduct? They need not fear
missing their way who were thus led, nor being lost who were thus
directed; they need not fear being benighted, who were thus illuminated,
nor being robbed, who were thus protected. And they who make the glory
of God their end, and the word of God their rule, the spirit of God the
guide of their affections, and the providence of God the guide of their
affairs, may be confident that the Lord goes before them, as truly is he
went before Israel in the wilderness, though not so sensibly. They had
sensible effects of God's going before them in this pillar. For, It led
them the way in that vast howling wilderness, in which there was no
road, no track, no way-marks through which they had no guides. When they
marched, this pillar went before them, at the rate that they could
follow, and appointed the place of their encampment, as infinite Wisdom
saw fit; which eased them from care, and secured them from danger, both
in moving, and in resting. It sheltered them from the heat by day, which
at sometimes of the year was extreme: And it gave them light by night
when they had occasion for it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p11">22. He took not away the pillar of the cloud, - No not
when they seemed to have less occasion for it: it never left them 'till
it brought them to the borders of Canaan. It was a cloud which the wind
could not scatter. There was something spiritual in this pillar of cloud
and fire.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p12">1. The children of Israel were baptized
unto Moses in this cloud, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. x. 2" id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p12.1" parsed="|1Cor|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10.2">1 Cor. x, 2</scripRef>. By coming under this cloud they signified their putting
themselves under the conduct and command of Moses. Protection draws
allegiance; this cloud was the badge of God's protection, and so became
the bond of their allegiance. Thus they were initiated, and admitted
under that government, now when they were entering upon the
wilderness.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xiv.ii-p13">2. And it signifies the special conduct and
protection which the church of Christ is under in this world.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="39.53%" prev="ii.iii.xiv.ii" next="ii.iii.xv.i" id="ii.iii.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XIV" id="ii.iii.xv-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="39.53%" prev="ii.iii.xv" next="ii.iii.xv.ii" id="ii.iii.xv.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xv.i-p1">Here is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p2">I. The extreme distress that Israel was in
at the Red-sea.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p3">1. Notice given of it to Moses before, ver.
1-4.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p4">2. The cause of it was Pharaoh's pursuit of
them, ver. 5-9.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p5">3. Israel was in a consternation upon it,
ver. 10-12.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p6">4. Moses endeavours to encourage them, ver.
13, 14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p7">II. The wonderful deliverance that God
wrought for them.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p8">1. Moses is instructed concerning it, ver.
15-18.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p9">2. Lines that could not be forced are set
between the camp of Israel and Pharaoh's camp, ver. 19, 20.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p10">3. By the divine power the Red-sea is
divided, ver. 21. and is made,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p11">1. A lane to the Israelites, who marched
safely through it, ver. 22- 29. But.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p12">2. To the Egyptians it was made,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p13">1. An ambush into which they were drawn,
ver. 23-25. And,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p14">2. A grave in which they were all buried,
ver. 26-28.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xv.i-p15">III. The impressions this made upon the
Israelites, ver. 30, 31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="39.55%" prev="ii.iii.xv.i" next="ii.iii.xvi" id="ii.iii.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p1">2. They were got to the edge of the wilderness, chap.
xiii, 20, and one stage or two would have brought them to Horeb, the
place appointed for their serving God, but instead of going forward,
they are ordered to turn short off, on the right-hand from Canaan, and
to march towards the Red-sea. When they were at Etham, there was no sea
in their way to obstruct their passage; but God himself orders them into
straits, which might give them an assurance, that when his purposes were
served, he would bring them out of those straits. Before Pi-hahiroth -
Or the straits of Hiroth, two great mountains, between which they
marched. Migdol and Baal-zephon were cities of Egypt and probably
garrison'd.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p2">3. They are entangled - Inclosed with mountains, and
garrisons, and deserts.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p3">5. And it was told the king that the people fled - He
either forgot, or would not own that they had departed with his consent;
and therefore was willing it should be represented to him as a revolt
from their allegiance.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p4">7. Captains over every one of them - Or rather over all
of them; distributing the command of them to his several Captains.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p5">8. With an high hand - Boldly, resolutely.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p6">9. Chariots and horsemen - It should seem he took no foot
with him, because the king's business required haste.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p7">10. They were sore afraid - They knew the strength of the
enemy, and their own weakness; numerous indeed they were, but all foot,
unarmed, undisciplined, dispirited, by long servitude, and now pent up,
so that they could not escape. On one hand was Pi- hahiroth, a range of
craggy rocks unpassable; on the other hand were Migdol and Baal-zephon,
forts upon the frontiers of Egypt; before them was the sea, behind them
were the Egyptians; so that there was no way open for them but upwards,
and thence their deliverance came.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p8">13. Moses answered not these fools according to their
folly: Instead of chiding he comforts them, and with an admirable
pretense of mind, not disheartened either by the threatenings of Egypt,
or the tremblings of Israel, stills their murmuring, Fear ye not, It is
our duty, when we cannot get out of our troubles, yet to get above our
fears, so that they may only serve to quicken our prayers and
endeavours, but may not prevail to silence our faith and hope. Stand
still, and think not to save yourselves either by fighting or flying;
wait God's orders, and observe them; Compose yourselves, by an entire
confidence in God, into a peaceful prospect of the great salvation God
is now about to work for you. Hold your peace, you need not so much as
give a shout against the enemy: the work shall be done without any
concurrence of yours. In times of great difficulty, it is our wisdom to
keep our spirits calm, quiet, and sedate, for then we are in the best
frame both to do our own work, and to consider the work of God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p9">15. Wherefore criest thou unto me - Moses though he was
assured of a good issue, yet did not neglect prayer. We read not of one
word he said in prayer, but he lifted up his heart to God, and God well
understood, and took notice of. Moses's silent prayer prevailed more
with God, than Israel's loud out-cries. But is God displeased with Moses
for praying? No, he asks this question, Wherefore criest thou unto me?
Wherefore shouldst thou press thy petition any farther, when it is
already granted? Moses has something else to do besides praying, he is
to command the hosts of Israel. Speak to them that they go forward -
Some think Moses had prayed not so much for their deliverance, he was
assured of that; as for the pardon of their murmurings, and God's
ordering them to go forward, was an intimation of the pardon. Moses bid
them stand still and expect orders from God: and now orders are given.
They thought they must have been directed either to the right hand, or
to the left; no, saith God, speak to them to go forward, directly to the
sea-side; as if there had lain a fleet of transport ships ready for them
to embark in. Let the children of Israel go as far as they can upon dry
ground, and then God will divide the sea. The same power could have
congealed the waters for them to pass over, but infinite wisdom chose
rather to divide the waters for them to pass through, for that way of
salvation is always pitched upon which is most humbling.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p10">19. The angel of God - Whose ministry was made use of in
the pillar of cloud and fire, went from before the camp of Israel, where
they did not now need a guide; there was no danger of missing their way
through the sea, and came behind them, where now they needed a guard,
the Egyptians being just ready to seize the hindmost of them. There it
was of use to the Israelites, not only to protect them, but to light
them through the sea; and at the same time it confounded the Egyptians,
so that they lost sight of their prey, just when they were ready to lay
hands on it. The word and providence of God have a black and dark side
towards sin and sinners, but a bright and pleasant side towards those
that are Israelites indeed.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p11">21. We have here the history of that work of wonder which
is so often mentioned both in the Old and New Testament. An instance of
God's almighty power in dividing the sea, and opening a passage through
the waters. It was a bay, or gulf, or arm of the sea, two or three
leagues over. The God of nature has not tied himself to its laws, but
when he pleases dispenseth with them, and then the fire doth not burn,
nor the water flow. They went through the sea to the opposite shore;
they walked upon dry land in the midst of the sea; and the pillar of
cloud being their rereward, the waters were a wall to them on their
right hand, and on their left. Moses and Aaron it is likely ventured
first, into this untrodden path, and then all Israel after them; and
this march through the paths of the great waters would make their march
afterwards through the wilderness less formidable. This march through
the sea was in the night, and not a moon-shine night, for it was seven
days after the full moon, so that they had no light but what they had
from the pillar of fire. This made it the more awful, but where God
leads us, he will light us; while we follow his conduct we shall not
want his comforts.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p12">23. And the Egyptians went in after them into the midst
of the sea - They thought, why might they not venture where Israel did?
They were more advantageously provided with chariots and horses, while
the Israelites were on foot.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p13">24. The Lord - Called the angel before, looked - With
indignation, upon the Egyptians, and troubled the Egyptians - With
terrible winds and lightnings and thunders, chap. xv, 10, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxvii. 18, 19" id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Ps|77|18|77|19" osisRef="Bible:Ps.77.18-Ps.77.19">Psalm lxxvii, 18, 19</scripRef>. Also with terror of mind.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p14">25. They had driven furiously, but now they drove
heavily, and found themselves embarrassed at every step; the way grew
deep, their hearts grew sad, their wheels dropt off, and the axle-trees
failed. They had been flying upon the back of Israel as the hawk upon
the dove; but now they cried, Let us flee from the face of Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p15">26. And the Lord said unto Moses, Stretch out thy hand
over the sea - And give a signal to the waters to close again, as before
upon the word of command they had opened to the right and the left. He
did so, and immediately the waters returned to their place, and
overwhelmed all the host of the Egyptians. Pharaoh and his servants,
that had hardened one another in sin, now fell together, and not one
escaped. An ancient tradition saith, That Pharaoh's magicians Jannes and
Jambres perished with the rest. Now God got him honour upon Pharaoh, a
rebel to God, and a slave to his own barbarous passions; perfectly lost
to humanity, virtue, and all true honour; here be lies buried in the
deep, a perpetual monument of divine justice: here he went down to the
pit, though he was the terror of the mighty in the land of the
living.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p16">28. After them - That is, after the Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p17">30. And Israel saw the Egyptians dead upon the shore -
The Egyptians were very curious in preserving the bodies of their great
men, but here the utmost contempt is poured upon all the grandees of
Egypt; see how they lie heaps upon heaps, as dung upon the face of the
earth.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xv.ii-p18">31. And Israel feared the Lord, and believed the Lord and
his servant Moses - Now they were ashamed of their distrusts and
murmurings; and in the mind they were in, they would never again despair
of help from heaven; no not in the greatest straits! They would never
again quarrel with Moses; nor talk of returning to Egypt. How well were
it for us, if we were, always in as good a frame, as we are in
sometimes!</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="39.70%" prev="ii.iii.xv.ii" next="ii.iii.xvi.i" id="ii.iii.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XV" id="ii.iii.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="39.70%" prev="ii.iii.xvi" next="ii.iii.xvi.ii" id="ii.iii.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.i-p1">In this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xvi.i-p2">I. Israel looks back upon Egypt with a song
of praise for their deliverance. Here is,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xvi.i-p3">1. The song itself, ver. 1-19.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xvi.i-p4">2. The solemn singing of it, ver. 20,
21.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xvi.i-p5">II. Israel marches forward in the
wilderness, ver. 22. Their discontent at the waters of Marah, ver. 23,
24. and the relief granted them, ver. 25, 26. Their satisfaction in the
waters of Elim, ver. 27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="39.70%" prev="ii.iii.xvi.i" next="ii.iii.xvii" id="ii.iii.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p1">1. Then sang Moses - Moses composed this song, and sang
it with the children of Israel. Doubtless he wrote it by inspiration,
and sang it on the spot. By this instance it appears that the singing of
psalms, as an act of religious worship, was used in the church of Christ
before the giving of the ceremonial law, therefore it is no part of it,
nor abolished with it: singing is as much the language of holy joy, as
praying is of holy desire. I will sing unto the Lord - All our joy must
terminate in God, and all our praises be offered up to him, for he hath
triumphed - All that love God triumph in his triumphs.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p2">2. Israel rejoiceth in God, as their strength, song, and
salvation - Happy therefore the people whole God is the Lord: They are
weak themselves, but he strengthens them, his grace is their strength:
they are oft in sorrow, but in him they have comfort, he is their song:
sin and death threaten them, but he is, and will be, their salvation. He
is their fathers God - This they take notice of, because being conscious
of their own unworthiness, they had reason to think that what God had
now done for them was for their fathers sake, <scripRef passage="Deut. iv. 37" id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Deut|4|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.4.37">Deut. iv, 37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p3">3. The Lord is a man of war - Able to deal with all those
that strive with their maker.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p4">4. He hath cast - With great force, as an arrow out of a
bow, so the Hebrew word signifies.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p5">7. In the greatness of thine excellency - By thy great
and excellent power.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p6">8. With the blast of thy nostrils - By thine anger: The
depths were congealed - Stood still, as if they had been frozen: In the
heart of the sea - The midst of it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p7">9. My lust - My desire both of revenge and gain.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p8">11. The gods - So called: Idols, or Princes: Glorious in
holiness - In justice, mercy and truth: Fearful in praises - To be
praised with reverence.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p9">12. The earth swallowed them - Their dead bodies sunk
into the sands on which they were thrown, which sucked them in.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p10">13. Thou in thy mercy hast led forth the People - Out of
the bondage of Egypt, and out of the perils of the Red-sea. Thou hast
guided them to thy holy habitation - Thou hast put them into the way to
it, and wilt in due time bring them to the end of that way.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p11">17. Thou shalt bring them in - If he thus bring them out
of Egypt, he will bring them into Canaan; for has he begun, and will he
not make an end? Thou wilt plant them in the place which thou hast made
for thee to dwell in - It is good dwelling where God dwells, in his
church on earth, and in his church in heaven. In the mountains - In the
mountainous country of Canaan: The sanctuary which thy hands have
established - Will as surely establish as if it was done already.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p12">18. The Lord shall reign forever and ever - They had now
seen an end of Pharaoh's reign, but time itself shall not put a period
to Jehovah's reign, which like himself is eternal.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p13">20. Miriam (or Mary, it is the same name) presided in an
assembly of the women, who (according to the common usage of those
times) with timbrels and dances, sung this song. Moses led the psalm,
and gave it out for the men, and then Miriam for the women. Famous
victories were wont to be applauded by the daughters of Israel, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xviii. 6, 7" id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p13.1" parsed="|1Sam|18|6|18|7" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.18.6-1Sam.18.7">1 Sam. xviii, 6, 7</scripRef>, so was this. When God brought Israel out of Egypt, it is
said, <scripRef passage="Micah vi. 4" id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p13.2" parsed="|Mic|6|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mic.6.4">Micah vi, 4</scripRef>, he sent before them Moses, Aaron, and Miriam; though we
read not of any thing remarkable that Miriam did but this. But those are
to be reckoned great blessings to a people, that go before them in
praising God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p14">21. And Miriam answered them - The men: They sung by
turns, or in parts.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p15">23. The name of it was called Marah - That is,
Bitterness.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvi.ii-p16">25. And he cried unto the Lord - It is the greatest
relief of the cares of magistrates and ministers, when those under their
charge make them uneasy, that they may have recourse to God by prayer;
he is the guide of the church's guides, and to the chief shepherd, the
under shepherds must on all occasions apply themselves: And the Lord
directed Moses to a tree, which he cast into the waters, and they were
made sweet - Some think this wood had a peculiar virtue in it for this
purpose, because it is said, God shewed him the tree. God is to be
acknowledged, not only in the creating things useful for man, but in
discovering their usefulness. But perhaps this was only a sign, and not
a means of the cure, no more than the brazen serpent. There he made a
statute and an ordinance, and there he proved them - That is, there he
put them upon trial, admitted them as probationers for his favour. In
short he tells them, ver. 26, what he expected from them, and that was,
in one word, obedience. They must diligently hearken to his voice, and
give ear to his commandments, and must take care, in every thing, to do
that which was right in God's sight, and to keep all his statutes. Then
I will put none of these diseases upon thee - That is, I will not bring
upon thee any of the plagues of Egypt. This intimates, that if they were
disobedient, the plagues which they had seen inflicted on their enemies
should be brought on them. But if thou wilt be obedient, thou shalt be
safe, the threatening is implied, but the promise is expressed, I am the
Lord that healeth thee - And will take care of thee wherever thou
goest.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="39.80%" prev="ii.iii.xvi.ii" next="ii.iii.xvii.i" id="ii.iii.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XVI" id="ii.iii.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="39.80%" prev="ii.iii.xvii" next="ii.iii.xvii.ii" id="ii.iii.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.i-p1">This chapter gives us an account of the victualling of
the camp of Israel.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xvii.i-p2">I. Their complaint for want of bread, ver.
1-3.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xvii.i-p3">II. The notice God gave them of the
provision he intended to make for them, ver. 4-12.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xvii.i-p4">III. The sending of the manna, ver.
13-15.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xvii.i-p5">IV. The laws and orders concerning it.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xvii.i-p6">1. That they should gather it daily, ver.
16-21.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xvii.i-p7">2. That they should gather a double portion
on the sixth day, ver. 22-26.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xvii.i-p8">3. That they should expect none on the
seventh day, ver. 27-31,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xvii.i-p9">4. That they should preserve a pot of it
for a memorial, ver 32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="39.81%" prev="ii.iii.xvii.i" next="ii.iii.xviii" id="ii.iii.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p1">1. A month's provision, it seems, the host of Israel took
with them out of Egypt, when they came thence on the 15th day of the
first month, which, by the 15th day of the second month, was all
spent.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p2">2. Then the whole congregation murmured against Moses and
Aaron - God's viceregents among them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p3">3. They so undervalue their deliverance, that they wish,
they had died in Egypt, nay, and died by the hand of the Lord too. That
is, by some of the plagues which cut off the Egyptians; as if it were
not the hand of the Lord, but of Moses only, that brought them into this
wilderness. 'Tis common for people to say of that pain, or sickness,
which they see not second causes of, It is what pleaseth God, as if that
were not so likewise which comes by the hand of man, or some visible
accident. We cannot suppose they had any great plenty in Egypt, how
largely soever they now talk of the flesh-pots, nor could they fear
dying for want in the wilderness while they had their flocks and herds
with them; but discontent magnifies what is past, and vilifies what is
present, without regard to truth or reason. None talk more absurdly than
murmurers.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p4">4. Man being made out of the earth, his Maker has wisely
ordered him food out of the earth, <scripRef passage="Psalm civ. 14" id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Ps|104|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.104.14">Psalm civ, 14</scripRef>. But the people of Israel typifying the church of the
first-born that are written in heaven, receiving their charters, laws
and commissions from heaven, from heaven also they received their food.
See what God designed in making this provision for them, that I may
prove them whether they will walk in my law or no - Whether they will
trust me, and whether they would serve him, and be ever faithful to so
good a master.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p5">5. They shall prepare - Lay up, grind, bake or boil.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p6">6. The Lord - And not we, (as you suggest) by our own
counsel.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p7">10. The glory of the Lord - An extra-ordinary and sudden
brightness.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p8">12. And ye shall know that I am the Lord your God - This
gave proof of his power as the Lord, and his particular favour to them
as their God; when God plagued the Egyptians, it was to make them know
that he is the Lord; when he provided for the Israelites, it was to make
them know that he was their God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p9">13. The quails came up, and covered the camp - So tame
that they might take up as many of them as they pleased. Next morning he
rained manna upon them, which was to be continued to them for their
daily bread.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p10">15. What is this? Manna descended from the clouds. It
came down in dew melted, and yet was itself of such a consistency as to
serve for nourishing strengthening food, without any thing else: It was
pleasant food; the Jews say it was palatable to all, according as their
tastes were. It was wholesome food, light of digestion. By this spare
and plain diet we are all taught a lesson of temperance, and forbidden
to desire dainties and varieties.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p11">16. An omer - The tenth part of an ephah: Near six pints,
wine- measure.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p12">19. Let no man leave 'till morning - But let them learn
to go to bed and sleep quietly, though they had not a bit of bread in
their tent, nor in all their camp, trusting God with the following day
to bring them their daily bread. Never was there such a market of
provisions as this, where so many hundred thousand men were daily
furnished without money, and without price: never was there such an open
house kept as God kept in the wilderness for 40 years together, nor such
free and plentiful entertainment given. And the same wisdom, power and
goodness that now brought food daily out of the clouds, doth in the
constant course of nature bring food yearly out of the earth, and gives
us all things richly to enjoy.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p13">23. Here is a plain intimation of the observing a seventh
day sabbath, not only before the giving of the law upon Mount Sinai, but
before the bringing of Israel out of Egypt and therefore from the
beginning. If the sabbath had now been first instituted, how could Moses
have understood what God said to him, ver. 4, concerning a double
portion to be gathered on the sixth day, without making any express
mention of the sabbath? And how could the people so readily take the
hint, ver. 22, even to the surprize of the rulers, before Moses had
declared that it was done with regard to the sabbath, if they had not
had some knowledge of the sabbath before? The setting apart of one day
in seven for holy work, and in order to that for holy rest, was a divine
appointment ever since God created man upon the earth.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p14">34. An omer of this manna was laid up in a golden pot as
we are told, <scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 4" id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Heb|9|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.4">Heb. ix, 4</scripRef>, and kept before the testimony, or the ark, when it was
afterwards made, The preservation of this manna from waste and
corruption, was a standing miracle; and therefore the more proper
memorial of this miraculous food. The manna is called spiritual meat, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. x. 3" id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p14.2" parsed="|1Cor|10|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10.3">1
Cor. x, 3</scripRef>, because it was typical of spiritual blessings. Christ
himself is the true manna, the bread of life, of which that was a
figure, <scripRef passage="John vi. 49-51" id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p14.3" parsed="|John|6|49|6|51" osisRef="Bible:John.6.49-John.6.51">John vi, 49-51</scripRef>. The word of God is the manna by which our souls are
nourished, <scripRef passage="Matt. iv. 4" id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p14.4" parsed="|Matt|4|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4.4">Matt. iv, 4</scripRef>. The comforts of the Spirit are hidden manna, <scripRef passage="Rev. ii. 17" id="ii.iii.xvii.ii-p14.5" parsed="|Rev|2|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.2.17">Rev. ii,
17</scripRef>. These comforts from heaven as the manna did, are the
support of the divine life in the soul while we are in the wilderness of
this world: it is food for Israelites, for those only that follow the
pillar of cloud and fire: it is to be gathered; Christ in the word is to
be applied to the soul, and the means of grace used: we must every one
of us gather for ourselves. There was manna enough for all, enough for
each, and none had too much; so in Christ there is a compleat
sufficiency, and no superfluity. But they that did eat manna hungered
again, died at last, and with many of them God was not well pleased:
whereas they that feed on Christ by faith shall never hunger, and shall
die no more, and with them God will be forever well pleased. The Lord
evermore give us this bread!</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="39.91%" prev="ii.iii.xvii.ii" next="ii.iii.xviii.i" id="ii.iii.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XVII" id="ii.iii.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="39.91%" prev="ii.iii.xviii" next="ii.iii.xviii.ii" id="ii.iii.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xviii.i-p1">In this chapter are recorded,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xviii.i-p2">I. The watering of the host of Israel. (1.)
In the wilderness they wanted water, ver. 1. (2.) In their want they
chide with Moses, ver. 2, 3. (3.) Moses cried to God, ver. 4. (4.) God
ordered him to smite the rock, and fetch water out of it; and he did so,
ver. 5, 6. (5.) The place named from it, ver. 7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xviii.i-p3">II. The defeating of the host of Amalek.
(1.) The victory obtained by the prayer of Moses, ver. 8-12. (2.) By the
sword of Joshua, ver. 13 (3.) A record kept of it, ver.14-16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="39.92%" prev="ii.iii.xviii.i" next="ii.iii.xix" id="ii.iii.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p1">1. They journeyed according to the commandment of the
Lord, led by the pillar of cloud and fire, and yet they came to a place
where there was no water for them to drink - We may be in the way of our
duty, and yet meet with troubles, which Providence brings us into for
the trial of our faith.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p2">5. Go on before the people - Though they spake of stoning
him. He must take his rod with him, not to summon some plague to
chastise them, but to fetch water for their supply. O the wonderful
patience and forbearance of God towards provoking sinners! He maintains
those that are at war with him, and reaches out the hand of his bounty
to those that lift up the heel against him. If God had only shewed Moses
a fountain of water in the wilderness, as he did to Hagar, not far from
hence, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxi. 19" id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Gen|21|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.21.19">Gen. xxi, 19</scripRef>, that had been a great favour; but that he might shew his
power as well as his pity, and make it a miracle of mercy, he gave them
water out of a rock. He directed Moses whither to go, appointed him to
take of the elders of Israel with him, to be witnesses of what was done,
ordered him to smite the rock, which he did, and immediately water came
out of it in great abundance, which ran throughout the camp in streams
and rivers, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxviii. 15, 16" id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Ps|78|15|78|16" osisRef="Bible:Ps.78.15-Ps.78.16">Psalm lxxviii, 15,
16</scripRef>, and followed them wherever they went in that wilderness:
God shewed his care of his people in giving them water when they wanted
it; his own power in fetching it out of a rock, and put an honour upon
Moses in appointing the water to flow out upon his smiting of the rock.
This fair water that came out of the rock is called honey and oil, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 13" id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p2.3" parsed="|Deut|32|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.13">Deut. xxxii, 13</scripRef>, because the people's thirst made it doubly pleasant; coming
when they were in extreme want. It is probable that the people digged
canals for the conveyance of it, and pools for the reception of it. Let
this direct us to live in a dependance,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p3">1. Upon God's providence even in the
greatest straits and difficulties;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p4">2. And upon Christ's grace; that rock was
Christ, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. x. 4" id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Cor|10|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10.4">1 Cor. x, 4</scripRef>. The graces and comforts of the Spirit are compared to
rivers of living waters, <scripRef passage="John vii. 38, 39" id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p4.2" parsed="|John|7|38|7|39" osisRef="Bible:John.7.38-John.7.39">John vii, 38,
39</scripRef>; iv, 14. These flow from Christ. And nothing will supply the
needs and satisfy the desires of a soul but water out of this rock. A
new name was upon this occasion given to the place, preserving the
remembrance of their murmuring, Massah - Temptation, because they
tempted God, Meribah - Strife, because they chide with Moses.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p5">8. Then Amalek came and fought with Israel - The
Amalekites were the posterity of Esau, who hated Jacob because of the
birth- right and blessing. They did not boldly front them as a generous
enemy, but without any provocation given, basely fell upon their rear,
and smote them that were faint and feeble.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p6">9. I will stand on the top of the hill with the rod of
God in my land - See how God qualifies his people for, and calls them to
various services for the good of his church; Joshua fights, Moses prays,
and both minister to Israel. This rod Moses held up, not so much to
Israel as to animate them; as to God by way of appeal to him; Is not the
battle the Lord's? Is not he able to help, and engaged to help? Witness
this rod! Moses was not only a standard-bearer, but an intercessor,
pleading with God for success and victory.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p7">10. Hur is supposed to have been the husband of
Miriam.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p8">11. And when Moses held vp his hand in prayer (so the
Chaldee explains it) Israel prevailed, but when he let down his hand
from prayer, Amalek prevailed - To convince Israel that the hand of
Moses (with whom they had just now been chiding) contributed more to
their safety than their own hands; the success rises and falls, as Moses
lifts up or lets down his hand. The church's cause is ordinarily more or
less successful, according as the church's friends are more or less
fervent in prayer.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p9">13. Though God gave the victory, yet it is said Joshua
discomfited Amalek, because Joshua was a type of Christ, and of the same
name, and in him it is that we are more than conquerors.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xviii.ii-p10">15. And Moses built an altar, and called it Jehovah-niffi
- The Lord is my banner. The presence and power of Jehovah was the
banner under which they were lifted, by which they were animated, and
kept together, and therefore which they erected in the day of their
triumph. In the name of our God we must always lift up our banners: He
that doth all the work should have all the praise. Write this for a
memorial - This is the first mention of writing we find in scripture;
and perhaps the command was not given till after the writing of the law
on tables of stone.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="40.00%" prev="ii.iii.xviii.ii" next="ii.iii.xix.i" id="ii.iii.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XVIII" id="ii.iii.xix-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="40.00%" prev="ii.iii.xix" next="ii.iii.xix.ii" id="ii.iii.xix.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xix.i-p1">This chapter is concerning Moses himself, and the affairs
of his own family.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xix.i-p2">I. Jethro his father-in-law brings him his
wife and children, ver. 1- 6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xix.i-p3">II. Moses entertains his father-in-law with
great respect, ver. 7. with good discourse, ver. 8-11. with a sacrifice
and a feast, ver. 12.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xix.i-p4">III. Jethro adviseth him about the
management of his business as a judge in Israel, to take other Judg. in
to his assistance, ver. 13-23. and Moses after some time takes his
counsel, ver. 24-26. They part, ver. 27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="40.01%" prev="ii.iii.xix.i" next="ii.iii.xx" id="ii.iii.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p1">1. Jethro to congratulate the happiness of Israel, and
particularly the honour of Moses his son-in-law; comes to rejoice with
them, as one that had a true respect both for them and for their God.
And also to bring Moses's wife and children to him. It seems he had sent
them back, probably from the inn where his wife's lothness to have her
son circumcised had like to have cost him his life, chap. iv, 25.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p2">3. The name of one was Gershom - A stranger, designing
thereby not only a memorial of his own condition, but a memorandum to
this son of his, for we are all strangers upon earth.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p3">4. The name of the other was Eliezer - My God a help: it
looks back to his deliverance from Pharaoh, when he made his escape
after the slaying of the Egyptian; but if this were the son that was
circumcised in the inn, I would rather translate it, The Lord is mine
help, and will deliver me from the sword of Pharaoh, which he had reason
to expect would be drawn against him, when he was going to fetch Israel
out of bondage.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p4">11. Now know I that JEHOVAH is greater than all gods -
That the God of Israel is greater than all pretenders; all deities, that
usurp divine honours: he silenceth them, subdues them all, and is
himself the only living and true God. He is also higher than all princes
and potentates, who also are called gods, and has both an incontestable
authority over them, and an irresistible power to control them; he
manages them all as he pleaseth, and gets honour upon them how great
soever they are. Now know I: he knew it before, but now he knew it
better; his faith grew up to a full assurance, upon this fresh evidence;
for wherein they dealt proudly - The magicians or idols of Egypt, or
Pharaoh and his grandees, opposing God, and setting up in competition
with him, he was above them. The magicians were baffled, Pharaoh
humbled, his powers broken, and Israel rescued out of their hands.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p5">12. And Jethro took a burnt offering for God - And
probably offered it himself, for he was a priest in Midian, and a
worshipper of the true God, and the priesthood was not yet settled in
Israel. And they did eat bread before God - Soberly, thankfully, in the
fear of God; and their talk such as became saints. Thus we must eat and
drink to the glory of God; as those that believe God's eye is upon
us.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p6">13. Moses sat to judge the people - To answer enquiries;
to acquaint them with the will of God in doubtful cases, and to explain
the laws of God that were already given.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p7">15. The people came to inquire of God - And happy was it
for them that they had such an oracle to consult. Moses was faithful
both to him that appointed him, and to them that consulted him, and made
them know the statutes of God, and his laws - His business was not to
make laws, but to make known God's laws: his place was but that of a
servant.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p8">16. I judge between one and another - And if the people
were as quarrelsome one with another as they were with God, he had many
causes brought before him, and the more because their trials put them to
no expence.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p9">17. Not good - Not convenient either for thee or
them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p10">19. Be thou for them to God-ward - That was an honour
which it was not fit any other should share with him in. Also whatever
concerned the whole congregation must pass through his hand, ver. 20.
But, he appointed Judg. in the several tribes and families, which should
try causes between man and man, and determine them, which would be done
with less noise, and more dispatch than in the general assembly. Those
whose gifts and stations are most eminent may yet be greatly furthered
in their work by the assistance of those that are every way their
inferiors. This is Jethro's advice; but he adds two qualifications to
his counsel. (1.)That great care should be taken in the choice of the
persons who should be admitted into this trust; it was requisite that
they should be men of the best character.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p11">1. For judgment and resolution, able men:
men of good sense, that understood business; and bold men, that would
not be daunted by frowns or clamours. Clear heads and stout hearts make
good Judges.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p12">2. For piety, such as fear God, who believe
there is a God above them, whose eye is upon them, to whom they are
accountable, and whose judgment they stand in awe of. Conscientious men,
that dare not do an ill thing, though they could do it never so secretly
and securely.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p13">3. For honesty, men of truth, whose word
one may take, and whose fidelity one may rely upon.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p14">4. For a generous contempt of worldly
wealth, hating covetousness, not only not seeking bribes, or aiming to
enrich themselves, but abhorring the thought of it. (2.) That he should
attend God's direction in the case, ver. 23. If thou shalt do this
thing, and God command thee so - Jethro knew that Moses had a better
counsellor than he was, and to his counsel he refers him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p15">24. So Moses hearkened unto the voice of his
father-in-law. When he came to consider the thing, he saw the
reasonableness of it, and resolved to put it in practice, which he did
soon after, when he had received directions from God. Those are not so
wise as they would be thought to be, who think themselves too wise to be
counselled; for a wise man will hear, and will increase learning, and
not slight good counsel, though given by an inferior.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p16">27. He went into his own land - It is supposed the
Kenites mentioned <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xv. 6" id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p16.1" parsed="|1Sam|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.15.6">1 Sam. xv,
6</scripRef>, were the posterity of Jethro, (compare <scripRef passage="Jude i. 16" id="ii.iii.xix.ii-p16.2" parsed="|Jude|1|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.1.16">Jude i, 16</scripRef>,) and they are taken under special protection, for the
kindness their ancestor shewed to Israel.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="40.10%" prev="ii.iii.xix.ii" next="ii.iii.xx.i" id="ii.iii.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XIX" id="ii.iii.xx-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="40.10%" prev="ii.iii.xx" next="ii.iii.xx.ii" id="ii.iii.xx.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xx.i-p1">This chapter introduces the giving of the law upon Mount
Sinai, which was one of the most sensible appearances of the divine
glory that ever was in this lower world. Here are,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xx.i-p2">I. The circumstances of time and place,
ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xx.i-p3">II. The covenant between God and Israel
settled in general. The gracious proposal God made to them, ver. 3-6.
And their consent to the proposal, ver. 7, 8.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xx.i-p4">III. Notice given three days before of
God's design to give the law out of a thick cloud, ver. 9. Orders given
to prepare the people to receive the law, ver. 10-13. and care taken to
execute those orders, ver. 14, 15.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xx.i-p5">IV. A terrible appearance of God's glory,
ver. 16-20.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xx.i-p6">V. Silence proclaimed, and strict charge
given to the people to observe a decorum while God spake to them, ver.
20-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="40.12%" prev="ii.iii.xx.i" next="ii.iii.xxi" id="ii.iii.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p1">1. In the third month after they came out of Egypt. It is
computed that the law was given just fifty days after their coming out
of Egypt, in remembrance of which the feast of Pentecost was observed
the fiftieth day after the passover, and in compliance with which the
spirit was poured out upon the apostles, at the feast of Pentecost,
fifty days after the death of Christ. Mount Sinai was a place which
nature, not art, had made conspicuous, for it was the highest in all
that range of mountains. Thus God put contempt upon cities and palaces,
setting up his pavilion on the top of a mountain, in a barren desert. It
is called Sinai, from the multitude of thorny bushes that over-spread
it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p2">3. Thus shalt thou say to the house of Jacob, and the
children of Israel - The people are called by the names both of Jacob
and Israel, to mind them that they who had lately been as low as Jacob
when he went to Padan-aram, were now grown as great as God made him when
he came from thence, and was called Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p3">4. Ye have seen what I did unto the Egyptians, and how I
bare you on Eagle's wings - An high expression of the wonderful
tenderness God shewed for them. It notes great speed; God not only came
upon the wing for their deliverance, but he hastened them out, as it
were upon the wing. Also that he did it with great ease, with the
strength as well as with the swiftness of an eagle. They that faint not,
nor are weary, are said to mount up with wings as eagles, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 31" id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Isa|40|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.31">Isaiah xl, 31</scripRef>. Especially it notes God's particular care of them, and
affection to them. Even Egypt was the nest in which these young ones
were first formed as the embryo of a nation: when by the increase of
their numbers they grew to some maturity, they were carried out of that
nest. I brought you unto myself - They were brought not only into a
state of liberty, but into covenant and communion with God. This, God
aims at in all the gracious methods of his providence and grace, to
bring us back to himself, from whom we have revolted, and to bring us
home to himself, in whom alone we can be happy.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p4">5. Then ye shall be a peculiar treasure to me - He doth
not instance in any one particular favour, but expresseth it in that
which was inclusive of all happiness, that he would be to them a God in
covenant, and they should be to him a people. Nay you shall be a
peculiar treasure: not that God was enriched by them, as a man is by his
treasure, but he was pleased to value and esteem them as a man doth his
treasure; they were precious in his sight. He took them under his
special care and protection, as a treasure that is kept under lock and
key. He distinguished them from, and dignified them above all people, as
a people devoted to him, and to his service.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p5">6. A kingdom of priests, a holy nation - All the
Israelites, if compared with other people, were priests unto God, so
near were they to him, so much employed in his immediate service, and
such intimate communion they had with him. The tendency of the laws
given them was to distinguish them from others, and engage them for God
as a holy nation. Thus all believers are, through Christ, made to our
God kings and priests, <scripRef passage="Rev. i. 6" id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Rev|1|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.1.6">Rev. i,
6</scripRef>, a chosen generation, a royal priesthood, <scripRef passage="1 Pet. ii. 9" id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p5.2" parsed="|1Pet|2|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.2.9">1 Pet. ii, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p6">7. And Moses laid before their faces all these words - He
not only explained to them what God had given him in charge, but put it
to their choice, whether they would accept these promises upon these
terms or no. His laying it to their faces speaks his laying it to their
consciences.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p7">8. And they answered together; all that the Lord hath
spoken we will do - Thus accepting the Lord to be to them a God, and
giving up themselves to be to him a people.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p8">10. Sanctify the people - As Job before sent and
sanctified his sons, <scripRef passage="Job i. 5" id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Job|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.1.5">Job i, 5</scripRef>. Sanctify them, that is, call them off from their worldly
business, and call them to religious exercises, meditation and prayer,
that they may receive the law from God's mouth with reverence and
devotion. Two things particularly were prescribed as instances of their
preparation. 1st, In token of cleansing of themselves from all sinful
pollutions, they must wash their clothes. Not that God regards our
clothes, but while they were washing their clothes, he would have them
think of washing their souls by repentance. It becomes us to appear in
clean clothes when we wait upon great men; so clean hearts are required
in our attendance on the great God. 2ndly, In token of their devoting
themselves entirely to religious exercises upon this occasion they must
abstain even from lawful enjoyments during these three days, and not
come at their wives.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p9">11. In the sight of all the people - Though they should
see no manner of similitude, yet they should see so much as would
convince them, that God was among them of a truth. And so high was the
top of Mount Sinai, that it is supposed not only the camp of Israel, but
even the countries about might discern some extraordinary appearance of
glory upon it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p10">12. Set bounds - Probably he drew a ditch round at the
foot of the hill, which none were to pass upon pain of death. This was
to intimate, 1st, That awful reverence which ought to possess the minds
of all that worship God. 2ndly, The distance which worshippers were kept
at under that dispensation, which we ought to take notice of, that we
may the more value our privilege under the gospel, having boldness to
enter into the holiest by the blood of Jesus, <scripRef passage="Heb. x. 19" id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Heb|10|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.10.19">Heb. x, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p11">13. When the trumpet soundeth long - Then let them take
their places at the foot of the mount. Never was so great a congregation
called together and preached to at once as this was here. No one man's
voice could have reached so many, but the voice of God did.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p12">16. Now at length is come that memorable day, in which
Israel heard the voice of the Lord God speaking to them out of the midst
of the fire and lived, <scripRef passage="Deut. iv. 33" id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Deut|4|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.4.33">Deut. iv,
33</scripRef>. Never was there such a sermon preached before or since, as
this, which was here preached to the church in the wilderness. For, the
preacher was God himself, ver. 17, The Lord descended in fire; and ver.
18. The Lord came down upon Mount Sinai. The Shechinah, or glory of the
Lord, appeared in the sight of all the people; he shined forth from
mount Paran with ten thousand of his saints, attended with a multitude
of the holy angels. Hence the law is said to be given by the disposition
of angels, <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 53" id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p12.2" parsed="|Acts|7|53|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.53">Acts vii, 53</scripRef>. He spake from Mount Sinai, hung with a thick cloud, ver.
16, covered with smoke, ver. 18, and made to quake greatly. Now it was
that the earth trembled at the presence of the Lord, and the mountains
skipped like rams, <scripRef passage="Psalm cxiv. 4, 7" id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p12.3" parsed="|Ps|114|4|0|0;|Ps|114|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.114.4 Bible:Ps.114.7">Psalm cxiv, 4, 7</scripRef>, that Sinai itself, though rough and rocky, melted from
before the Lord God of Israel, <scripRef passage="Jude v. 5" id="ii.iii.xx.ii-p12.4" parsed="|Jude|5|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.5.5">Jude v, 5</scripRef>. The congregation was called together by the sound of a
trumpet exceeding loud, ver. 16, and waxing louder and louder, ver. 19.
This was done by the ministry of the angels, and made all the people
tremble. The introductions to the service were thunders and lightnings,
ver. 16. These have natural causes; but the scripture directs us in a
particular manner to take notice of the power of God, and his terror in
them. Thunder is the voice of God, and lightning the fire of God, proper
to engage both the learning senses of seeing and hearing.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="40.25%" prev="ii.iii.xx.ii" next="ii.iii.xxi.i" id="ii.iii.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XX" id="ii.iii.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="40.25%" prev="ii.iii.xxi" next="ii.iii.xxi.ii" id="ii.iii.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.i-p1">All things being prepared for the solemn promulgation of
the divine law, we have in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxi.i-p2">I. The ten commandments as God himself
spake them upon Mount Sinai, ver. 1-17.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxi.i-p3">II. The impressions made upon the people,
thereby, ver. 18-21.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxi.i-p4">III. Some particular instructions which God
gave to Moses, relating to his worship, ver. 22-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="40.25%" prev="ii.iii.xxi.i" next="ii.iii.xxii" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p1">1. God spake all these words - The law of the ten
commandments is a law of God's making; a law of his own speaking. God
has many ways of speaking to the children of men by his spirit,
conscience, providences; his voice in all which we ought carefully to
attend to: but he never spake at any time upon any occasion so as he
spake the ten commandments, which therefore we ought to hear with the
more earnest heed. This law God had given to man before, it was written
in his heart by nature; but sin had so defaced that writing, that it was
necessary to revive the knowledge of it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p2">2. I am the Lord thy God - Herein, God asserts his own
authority to enact this law; and proposeth himself as the sole object of
that religious worship which is enjoined in the four first commandments.
They are here bound to obedience.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p3">1. Because God is the Lord, Jehovah,
self-existent, independent, eternal, and the fountain of all being and
power; therefore he has an incontestable right to command us.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p4">2. He was their God; a God in covenant with
them; their God by their own consent.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p5">3. He had brought them out of the land of
Egypt - Therefore they were bound in gratitude to obey him, because he
had brought them out of a grievous slavery into a glorious liberty. By
redeeming them, he acquired a farther right to rule them; they owed
their service to him, to whom they owed their freedom. And thus, Christ,
having rescued us out of the bondage of sin, is entitled to the best
service we can do him. The four first commandments, concern our duty to
God (commonly called the first-table.) It was fit those should be put
first, because man had a Maker to love before he had a neighbour to
love, and justice and charity are then only acceptable to God when they
flow from the principles of piety.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p6">3. The first commandment is concerning the object of our
worship, Jehovah, and him only, Thou shalt have no other gods before me
- The Egyptians, and other neighbouring nations, had many gods,
creatures of their own fancy. This law was pre-fixed because of that
transgression; and Jehovah being the God of Israel, they must entirely
cleave to him, and no other, either of their own invention, or borrowed
from their neighbours. The sin against this commandment, which we are
most in danger of, is giving that glory to any creature which is due to
God only. Pride makes a God of ourselves, covetousness makes a God of
money, sensuality makes a God of the belly. Whatever is loved, feared,
delighted in, or depended on, more than God, that we make a God of. This
prohibition includes a precept which is the foundation of the whole law,
that we take the Lord for our God, accept him for ours, adore him with
humble reverence, and set our affections entirely upon him. There is a
reason intimated in the last words before me. It intimates,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p7">1. That we cannot have any other God but he
will know it.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p8">2. That it is a sin that dares him to his
face, which he cannot, will not, overlook. The second commandment is
concerning the ordinances of worship, or the way in which God will be
worshipped, which it is fit himself should appoint. Here is,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p9">1. The prohibition; we are forbidden to
worship even the true God by images, ver. 4, 5. First, The Jews (at
least after the captivity) thought themselves forbidden by this to make
any image or picture whatsoever. It is certain it forbids making any
image of God, for to whom can we liken him? <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 18, 25" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Isa|40|18|0|0;|Isa|40|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.18 Bible:Isa.40.25">Isaiah xl, 18, 25</scripRef>. It also forbids us to make images of God in our fancies, as
if he were a man as we are. Our religious worship must be governed by
the power of faith, not by the power of imagination. Secondly, They must
not bow down to them - Shew any sign of honour to them, much less serve
them by sacrifice, or any other act of religious worship. When they paid
their devotion to the true God, they must not have any image before them
for the directing, exciting, or assisting their devotion. Though the
worship was designed to terminate in God, it would not please him if it
came to him through an image. The best and most ancient lawgivers among
the Heathen forbad the setting up of images in their temples. It was
forbidden in Rome by Numa a Pagan prince, yet commanded in Rome by the
Pope, a Christian bishop. The use of images in the church of Rome, at
this day, is so plainly contrary to the letter of this command, that in
all their catechisms, which they put into the hand of the people, they
leave out this commandment, joining the reason of it to the first, and
so the third commandment they call the second, the fourth the third,
&amp;c. only to make up the number ten, they divide the tenth into two.
For I the Lord Jehovah, thy God, am a jealous God, especially in things
of this nature. It intimates the care he has of his own institutions,
his displeasure against idolaters, and that he resents every thing in
his worship that looks like, or leads to, idolatry: visiting the
iniquity of the fathers upon the children unto the third and fourth
generation - Severely punishing. Nor is it an unrighteous thing with God
if the parents died in their iniquity, and the children tread in their
steps, when God comes, by his judgments, to reckon with them, to bring
into the account the idolatries their fathers were guilty of. Keeping
mercy for thousands of persons, thousands of generations, of them that
love me and keep my commandments - This intimates, that the second
commandment, though in the letter of it is only a prohibition of false
worship, yet includes a precept of worshipping God in all those
ordinances which he hath instituted. As the first commandment requires
the inward worship of love, desire, joy, hope, so this the outward
worship of prayer and praise, and solemn attendance on his word. This
mercy shall extend to thousands, much further than the wrath threatened
to those that hate him, for that reaches but to the third or fourth
generation.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p10">7. The third commandment is concerning the manner of our
worship; Where we have,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p11">1. A strict prohibition. Thou shalt not
take the name of the Lord thy God in vain - Supposing that, having taken
Jehovah for their God, they would make mention of his name, this command
gives a caution not to mention it in vain, and it is still as needful as
ever. We take God's name in vain, First, By hypocrisy, making profession
of God's name, but not living up to that profession. Secondly, By
covenant breaking. If we make promises to God, and perform not to the
Lord our vows, we take his name in vain. Thirdly, By rash swearing,
mentioning the name of God, or any of his attributes, in the form of an
oath, without any just occasion for it, but to no purpose, or to no good
purpose. Fourthly, By false- swearing, which some think is chiefly
intended in the letter of the commandment. Fifthly, By using the name of
God lightly and carelessly. The profanation of the form of devotion is
forbidden, as well as the profanation of the forms of swearing; as also,
the profanation of any of those things whereby God makes himself known.
For the Lord will not hold him guiltless - Magistrates that punish other
offenses, may not think themselves concerned to take notice of this; but
God, who is jealous for his honour, will not connive at it. The sinner
may perhaps hold himself guiltless, and think there is no harm in it; to
obviate which suggestion, the threatening is thus expressed, God will
not hold him guiltless - But more is implied, that God will himself be
the avenger of those that take his name in vain; and they will find it a
fearful thing to fall into the hands of the living God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p12">8. The fourth commandment concerns the time of worship;
God is to be served and honoured daily; but one day in seven is to be
particularly dedicated to his honour, and spent in his service. Remember
the sabbath day, to keep it holy; in it thou shalt do no manner of work
- It is taken for granted that the sabbath was instituted before. We
read of God's blessing and sanctifying a seventh day from the beginning,
<scripRef passage="Gen. ii. 3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Gen|2|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.2.3">Gen. ii, 3</scripRef>, so that this was not the enacting of a new law, but the
reviving of an old law. 1st. They are told what is the day, they must
observe, a seventh after six days labour, whether this was the seventh
by computation from the first seventh, or from the day of their coming
out of Egypt, or both, is not certain. A late pious Writer seems to
prove, That the sabbath was changed, when Israel came out of Egypt;
which change continued till our Lord rose again: But that then the
Original Sabbath was restored. And he makes it highly probable, at
least, That the sabbath we observe, is the seventh day from the
creation. 2ndly, How it must be observed;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p13">1. As a day of rest; they were to do no
manner of work on this day, in their worldly business.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p14">2. As a holy day, set apart to the honour
of the holy God, and to be spent in holy exercises. God, by his blessing
it, had made it holy; they, by solemn blessing him, must keep it holy,
and not alienate it to any other purpose than that for which the
difference between it and other days was instituted. 3rdly, Who must
observe it? Thou and thy son and thy daughter - The wife is not
mentioned, because she is supposed to be one with the husband, and
present with him, and if he sanctify the sabbath, it is taken for
granted she will join with him; but the rest of the family is instanced
in it, children and servants must keep it according to their age and
capacity. In this, as in other instances of religion, it is expected
that masters of families should take care, not only to serve the Lord
themselves, but that their houses also should serve him. Even the
proselyted strangers must observe a difference between this day and
other days, which, if it laid some restraint upon them then, yet proved
a happy indication of God's gracious design, to bring the Gentiles into
the church. By the sanctification of the sabbath, the Jews declared that
they worshipped the God that made the world, and so distinguished
themselves from all other nations, who worshipped gods which they
themselves made. God has given us an example of rest after six days
work; he rested the seventh day - Took a complacency in himself, and
rejoiced in the work of his hand, to teach us on that day, to take a
complacency in him, and to give him the glory of his works. The sabbath
begun in the finishing of the work of creation; so will the everlasting
sabbath in the finishing of the work of providence and redemption; and
we observe the weekly sabbath in expectation of that, as well as in
remembrance of the former, in both conforming ourselves to him we
worship. He hath himself blessed the sabbath day and sanctified it. He
hath put an honour upon it; it is holy to the Lord, and honourable; and
he hath put blessings into it which he hath encouraged us to expect from
him in the religious observation of that day. Let us not profane,
dishonour, and level that with common time, which God's blessing hath
thus dignified and distinguished.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p15">12. We have here the laws of the second table, as they
are commonly called; the six last commandments which concern our duty to
ourselves, and one another, and are a comment upon the second great
commandment, Thou shalt love thy neighbour as thyself. As religion
towards God is, an essential branch of universal righteousness, so
righteousness towards men is an essential branch of true religion:
godliness and honesty must go together. The fifth commandment is
concerning the duties we owe to our relations; that of children to their
parents is only instanced in, honour thy father and thy mother, which
includes,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p16">1. an inward esteem of them, outwardly
expressed upon all occasions in our carriage towards them; fear them, <scripRef passage="Lev. xix. 3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Lev|19|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.3">Lev. xix, 3</scripRef>, give them reverence, <scripRef passage="Heb. xii. 9" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p16.2" parsed="|Heb|12|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.12.9">Heb. xii, 9</scripRef>. The contrary to this is mocking at them or despising
them,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p17">2. Obedience to their lawful commands; so
it is expounded, <scripRef passage="Eph. vi. 1-3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Eph|6|1|6|3" osisRef="Bible:Eph.6.1-Eph.6.3">Eph. vi, 1-3</scripRef>. Children obey your parents; come when they call you, go
where they send you, do what they bid you, do not what they forbid you;
and this cheerfully, and from a principle of love. Though you have said
you will not, yet afterwards repent and obey.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p18">3. Submission to their rebukes,
instructions and corrections, not only to the good and gentle, but also
to the froward.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p19">4. Disposing of themselves with the advice,
direction and consent of parents, not alienating their property, but
with their approbation.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p20">5. endeavouring in every thing to be the
comfort of their parents, and to make their old age easy to them;
maintaining them if they stand in need of support. That thy days may be
long in the land which the Lord thy God giveth thee - This promise,
(which is often literally fulfilled) is expounded in a more general
sense <scripRef passage="Eph. vi. 3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p20.1" parsed="|Eph|6|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.6.3">Eph. vi, 3</scripRef>. That it may be well with thee, and thou mayst live long on
the earth - Those that in conscience towards God keep this and other of
God's commandments, may be sure it shall be well with them, and they
shall live as long on the earth as infinite wisdom sees good for, them,
and what they may seem to be cut short of on earth, shall be abundantly
made up in eternal life, the heavenly Canaan which God will give
them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p21">13. Thou shalt not kill - Thou shalt not do any thing
hurtful to the health, or life of thy own body, or any other's. This
doth not forbid our own necessary defense, or the magistrates putting
offenders to death; but it forbids all malice and hatred to any, for he
that hateth his brother is a murderer, and all revenge arising
therefrom; likewise anger and hurt said or done, or aimed to be done in
a passion; of this our saviour expounds this commandment, <scripRef passage="Matt. v. 22" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p21.1" parsed="|Matt|5|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.5.22">Matt. v, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p22">14. Thou shalt not commit adultery - This commandment
forbids all acts of uncleanness, with all those desires, which produce
those acts and war against the soul.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p23">15. Thou shalt not steal - This command forbids us to rob
ourselves of what we have, by sinful spending, or of the use and comfort
of it by sinful sparing; and to rob others by invading our neighbour's
rights, taking his goods, or house, or field, forcibly or clandestinely,
over-reaching in bargains, not restoring what is borrowed or found,
with-holding just debts, rents or wages; and, which is worst of all, to
rob the public in the coin or revenue, or that which is dedicated to the
service of religion.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p24">16. Thou shalt not bear false witness - This forbids,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p25">1. Speaking falsely in any matter, lying,
equivocating, and any way devising and designing to deceive our
neighbour.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p26">2. Speaking unjustly against our neighbour,
to the prejudice of his reputation; And</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p27">3. (which is the highest offense of both
these kinds put together) Bearing false witness against him, laying to
his charge things that he knows not, either upon oath, by which the
third commandment, the sixth or eighth, as well as this, are broken, or
in common converse, slandering, backbiting, tale-bearing, aggravating
what is done amiss, and any way endeavouring to raise our own reputation
upon the ruin of our neighbour's.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p28">17. Thou shalt not covet - The foregoing commands
implicitly forbid all desire of doing that which will be an injury to
our neighbour, this forbids all inordinate desire of having that which
will be a gratification to ourselves. O that such a man's house were
mine! such a man's wife mine! such a man's estate mine! This is
certainly the language of discontent at our own lot, and envy at our
neighbour's, and these are the sins principally forbidden here. God give
us all to see our face in the glass of this law, and to lay our hearts
under the government of it!</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p29">18. They removed and stood afar off - Before God began to
speak, they were thrusting forward to gaze, but now they were
effectually cured of their presumption, and taught to keep their
distance.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p30">19. Speak thou with us - Hereby they obliged themselves
to acquiesce in the mediation of Moses, they themselves nominating him
as a fit person to deal between them and God, and promising to hearken
to him as to God's messenger.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p31">20. Fear not - That is, Think not that this thunder and
fire is, designed to consume you. No; it was intended, (1.) To prove
them, to try how they could like dealing with God immediately, without a
mediator, and so to convince them how admirably well God had chosen for
them in putting Moses into that office. Ever since Adam fled upon
hearing God's voice in the garden, sinful man could not bear either to
speak to God, or hear from him immediately. (2.) To keep them to their
duty, and prevent their sinning against God. We must not fear with
amazement; but we must always have in our minds a reverence of God's
majesty, a dread of his displeasure, and an obedient regard to his
sovereign authority.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p32">21. While the people continued to stand afar off - Afraid
of God's wrath, Moses drew near unto the thick darkness; he was made to
draw near, so the word is: Moses of himself durst not have ventured into
the thick darkness if God had not called him, and encouraged him, and,
as some of the Rabbins suppose, sent an angel to take him by the hand,
and lead him up.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p33">22. Moses being gone into the thick darkness where God
was, God there spoke in his hearing only, all that follows from hence to
the end of chap.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p34">23, which is mostly an exposition of the ten
commandments; and he was to transmit it to the people. The laws in these
verses relate to God's worship. Ye have seen that I have talked with you
from heaven - Such was his wonderful condescension; ye shall not make
gods of silver - This repetition of the second commandment comes in
here, because they were more addicted to idolatry than to any other
sin.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p35">24. An altar of earth - It is meant of occasional altars,
such as they reared in the wilderness before the tabernacle was erected,
and afterwards upon special emergencies, for present use. They are
appointed to make these very plain, either of earth or of unhewn stones.
That they might not be tempted to think of a graven image, they must not
so much as hew the stones into shape, that they made their altars of,
but pile them up as they were in the rough. In all places where I record
my name - Or where my name is recorded, that is, where I am worshipped
in sincerity, I will come unto thee, and will bless thee.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxi.ii-p36">26. Neither shall thou go at by steps unto mine altar -
Indeed afterwards God appointed an altar ten cubits high. But it is
probable, they went not up to that by steps, but by a sloping
ascent.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="40.58%" prev="ii.iii.xxi.ii" next="ii.iii.xxii.i" id="ii.iii.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXI" id="ii.iii.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="40.58%" prev="ii.iii.xxii" next="ii.iii.xxii.ii" id="ii.iii.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxii.i-p1">The laws recorded in this chapter relate to the fifth and
sixth commandments; and though not accommodated to our constitution,
especially in point of servitude yet are of great use for the
explanation of the moral law, and the rules of natural justice.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxii.i-p2">I. Here are several enlargements upon the
fifth commandment, which concerns particular relations. (1.) The duty of
masters towards their servants, their men servants ver. 2-6. and
maid-servants, ver. 7-11. (2.) The punishment of disobedient children
that strike their parents, ver. 15. or curse them, ver. 17.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxii.i-p3">II. Upon the sixth commandment, which
forbids all violence offered to the person of man. Here is, (1.)
Concerning murder, ver. 12-14. (2.) Man-stealing, ver, 16. (3.) Assault
and battery, ver. 18, 19. (4.) Correcting a servant, ver. 20, 21 (5.)
Hurting a woman with child, ver. 22, 23. (6.) The law of retaliation,
ver. 24, 25. (7.) Maiming a servant, ver. 26, 27. (8.) An ox goring,
ver. 26-32. (9.) Damage by opening a pit, ver. 33, 34. (10.) Cattle
fighting, ver 35, 36.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="40.59%" prev="ii.iii.xxii.i" next="ii.iii.xxiii" id="ii.iii.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxii.ii-p1">1. The first verse is the general title of the laws
contained in this and the two following chapters. Their government being
purely a theocracy; that which in other states is to be settled by human
prudence, was directed among them by a divine appointment. These laws
are called judgments; because their magistrates were to give judgment
according to them. In the doubtful cases that had hitherto occurred,
Moses had particularly inquired of God, but now God gave him statutes in
general, by which to determine particular cases. He begins with the laws
concerning servants, commanding mercy and moderation towards them. The
Israelites had lately been servants themselves, and now they were become
not only their own matters, but masters of servants too; lest they
should abuse their servants as they themselves had been abused,
provision was made for the mild and gentle usage of servants.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxii.ii-p2">2. If thou buy an Hebrew servant - Either sold by him or
his parents through poverty, or by the Judges for his crimes, yet even
such a one was to continue in slavery but seven years at the most.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxii.ii-p3">6. For ever - As long as he lives, or till the year of
Jubilee.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxii.ii-p4">8. Who hath betrothed her to himself - For a concubine,
or secondary Wife. Not that Masters always took Maid-servants on these
terms.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxii.ii-p5">9. After the manner of daughters - He shall give her a
portion, as to a daughter.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxii.ii-p6">20. Direction is given what should be done, if a servant
died by his master's correction. This servant must not be an Israelite,
but a Gentile slave, as the Negroes to our planters; and it is supposed
that he smite him with a rod, and not with any thing that was likely to
give a mortal wound, yet if he died under his hand, he should be
punished for his cruelty, at the discretion of the Judges, upon
consideration of circumstances.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxii.ii-p7">24. Eye for eye - The execution of this law is not put
into the hands of private persons, as if every man might avenge himself,
which would introduce universal confusion. The tradition of the elders
seems to have put this corrupt gloss upon it. But magistrates had an eye
to this rule in punishing offenders, and doing right to those that are
injured.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="40.63%" prev="ii.iii.xxii.ii" next="ii.iii.xxiii.i" id="ii.iii.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXII" id="ii.iii.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="40.63%" prev="ii.iii.xxiii" next="ii.iii.xxiii.ii" id="ii.iii.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.i-p1">The laws of this chapter relate,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxiii.i-p2">I. To the eighth commandment, concerning
theft, ver. 1-4 Trespass by cattle, ver. 5. Damage by fire, ver. 6.
Trusts, ver. 7- 13. Borrowing cattle, ver. 14, 15. Or money, ver.
25-27.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxiii.i-p3">II. To the seventh commandment. Against
fornication, ver. 16, 17. Bestiality, ver. 19.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxiii.i-p4">III. To the first table. Forbidding
witchcraft, ver. 18. Idolatry, ver. 20. Commanding to offer the
first-fruits, ver. 29. 30.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxiii.i-p5">IV. To the poor, ver. 21-24.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxiii.i-p6">V. To the civil government, ver. 28.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxiii.i-p7">VI. To the Jewish nation, ver. 13.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXII" progress="40.64%" prev="ii.iii.xxiii.i" next="ii.iii.xxiv" id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p1">1. Five oxen for an ox, and four sheep for a sheep - More
for an ox than for a sheep, because the owner, besides all the other
profit, lost the daily labour of his ox. If we were not able to make
restitution, he must be sold for a slave: the court of judgment was to
do it, and it is likely the person robbed received the money. Thus with
us in some cases, felons are transported to the Plantations, where only,
Englishmen know what slavery is. But let it be observed, the sentence is
not slavery, but banishment: nor can any Englishman be sold, unless he
first indent himself to the captain that carries him over. 2. If a thief
broke a house in the night, and was killed in the doing it, his blood
was upon his own head. But if it were in the day-time that the thief was
killed, he that killed him was accountable for it, unless it were in the
necessary defense of his own life.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p2">3. For he should make full restitution - This the law
determined: not that he should die.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p3">4. In his hand alive - Not killed, nor sold, as ver. 1,
so that the owner recover it with less charge and trouble.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p4">5. He that wilfully put his cattle into his neighbour's
field, must make restitution of the best of his own. The Jews hence
observed it as a general rule, that restitution must always be made of
the best; and that no man should keep any cattle that were likely to
trespass upon his neighbour, or do him any damage.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p5">6. He that designed only the burning of thorns might
become accessary to the burning of corn, and should not be held
guiltless. If the fire did mischief, he that kindled it must answer for
it, though it could not be proved that he designed the mischief. Men
must suffer for their carelessness, as well as for their malice. It will
make us very careful of ourselves, if we consider that we are
accountable not only for the hurt we do, but for the hurt we occasion
through inadvertency.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p6">7. If a man deliver goods, suppose to a carrier to be
conveyed, or to a warehouse-keeper to be preserved, or cattle to a
farmer to be fed upon a valuable consideration, and a special confidence
reposed in the person they are lodged with; in case these goods be
stolen or lost, perish or be damaged, if it appear that it was not by
any fault of the trustee, the owner must stand to the loss, otherwise he
that has been false to his trust must be compelled to make
satisfaction.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p7">14. If a man (suppose) lent his team to his neighbour, if
the owner were with it, or were to receive profit for the loan of it,
whatever harm befel the cattle the owner must stand to the loss of it:
but if the owner were so kind to the borrower as to lend it him gratis,
and put such a confidence in him as to trust it from under his own eye,
then, if any harm happened, the borrower must make it good. Learn hence
to be very careful not to abuse any thing that is lent to us; it is not
only unjust but base and disingenuous, we should much rather chuse to
lose ourselves, than that any should sustain loss by their kindness to
us.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p8">17. If the father refused, he shall pay money - This
shews how ill a thing it is, and by no means to be allowed, that
children should marry without their parents consent: even here where the
divine law appointed the marriage, both as a punishment to him that had
done wrong, and a recompence to her that had suffered wrong, yet there
was an express reservation for the father's power; if he denied his
consent, it must be no marriage.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p9">18. Witchcraft not only gives that honour to the devil
which is due to God alone, but bids defiance to the divine providence,
wages war with God's government, puts his work into the devil's hand
expecting him to do good and evil. By our law, consulting, covenanting
with, invocating or employing any evil spirit to any intent whatever,
and exercising any enchantment, charm, or sorcery, whereby hurt shall be
done to any person, is made felony, without benefit of clergy; also
pretending to tell where goods lost or stolen may be found, is an
iniquity punishable by the judge, and the second offense with death.
This was the case in former times. But we are wiser than our
fore-fathers. We believe, no witch ever did live! At least, not for
these thousand years.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p10">21. A stranger must not be abused, not wronged in
judgment by the magistrates, not imposed upon in contracts, nor any
advantage taken of his ignorance or necessity, no, nor must he be
taunted, or upbraided with his being a stranger; for all these were
vexations. For ye were strangers in Egypt - And knew what it was to be
vexed and oppressed there. Those that have themselves been in poverty
and distress, if Providence enrich and enlarge them, ought to shew a
particular tenderness towards those that are now in such circumstances
as they were in formerly, now doing to them as they then wished to be
done by.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p11">22. Ye shall not afflict the widow or fatherless child -
That is, ye shall comfort and assist them, and be ready upon all
occasions to shew them kindness. In making just demands from them, their
condition must be considered who have lost those that should protect
them: they are supposed to be unversed in business, destitute of advice,
timorous, and of a tender spirit; and therefore must be treated with
kindness and compassion, and no advantage taken against them, nor any
hardship put upon them, which a husband or a father would have sheltered
them from.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p12">25. If thou lend - (1.) They must not receive use for
money from any that borrowed for necessity. And such provision the law
made for the preserving estates to their families by the year of
Jubilee, that a people who had little concern in trade could not be
supposed to borrow money but for necessity; therefore it was generally
forbidden among themselves; but to a stranger they were allowed to lend
upon usury. This law therefore in the strictness of it seems to have
been peculiar to the Jewish state; but in the equity of it, it obligeth
us to shew mercy to those we have advantage against, and to be content
to share with those we lend to in loss as well as profit, if Providence
cross them: and upon this condition it seems as lawful to receive
interest for my money, which another takes pains with, and improves, as
it is to receive rent for my land, which another takes pains with, and
improves, for his own use. (2.) They must not take a poor man's
bed-clothes in pawn; but if they did, must restore them by bed-time.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p13">28. Thou shalt not revile the gods - That is, the Judges
and magistrates. Princes and magistrates are our fathers, whom the fifth
commandment obligeth us to honour, and forbids us to revile. St. Paul
applies this law to himself, and owns that he ought not to speak evil of
the ruler of his people, no, not though he was then his most unrighteous
persecutor, <scripRef passage="Acts xxiii. 5" id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Acts|23|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.23.5">Acts xxiii,
5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p14">29. The first-born of thy sons shalt thou give unto me -
And much more reason have we to give ourselves and all we have to God,
who spared not his own Son, but delivered him up for us all. The first
ripe of their corn they must not delay to offer; there is danger if we
delay our duty, lest we wholly omit it; and by slipping the first
opportunity in expectation of another, we suffer Satan to cheat us of
all our time.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiii.ii-p15">31. Ye shall be holy unto me - And one mark of that
honourable distinction is appointed in their diet, which was, that they
should not eat any flesh that was torn of beasts - Both because the
blood was not duly taken out of it, and because the clean beast was
ceremonially defiled, by the touch of the unclean.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="40.77%" prev="ii.iii.xxiii.ii" next="ii.iii.xxiv.i" id="ii.iii.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXIII" id="ii.iii.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxiv-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="40.77%" prev="ii.iii.xxiv" next="ii.iii.xxiv.ii" id="ii.iii.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.i-p1">This chapter concludes the acts that passed in the first
session (if I may so call it) upon Mount Sinai. Here are,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxiv.i-p2">I. Some laws of universal obligation,
relating especially to the ninth commandment, against bearing false
witness, ver. 1. and giving false judgement, ver. 2, 3, 6, 7, 8. Also a
law of doing good to our enemies, ver. 4, 5. and not oppressing
strangers, ver. 9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxiv.i-p3">II. Some laws peculiar to the Jews: the
sabbatical years, ver. 10, 11. the three annual feasts, ver. 14-17. with
laws pertaining thereto.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxiv.i-p4">III. Gracious promises of completing the
mercy God had begun for them, upon condition of their obedience, that
God would conduct them through the wilderness, ver 20-24. that he would
prosper all they had, ver. 25, 26, that he would put them in possession
of Canaan, ver. 27-31. But they must not mingle themselves with the
nations, ver. 32, 33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="40.79%" prev="ii.iii.xxiv.i" next="ii.iii.xxv" id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p1">1. Thou shalt not raise, the margin reads, Thou shalt not
receive a false report, for sometimes the receiver in this case is as
bad as the thief; and a backbiting tongue would not do so much mischief,
if it were not countenanced. Sometimes we cannot avoid hearing a false
report, but we must not receive it, we must not hear it with pleasure,
nor easily give credit to it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p2">2. Thou shalt not follow a multitude to do evil - General
usage will never excuse us in any ill practice; nor is the broad way
ever the safer for its being crowded. We must inquire what we ought to
do, not what the most do; because we must be judged by our master, not
our fellow servants; and it is too great a compliment, to be willing to
go to hell for company.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p3">7. Keep thee far from a false matter - From assisting or
abetting an ill thing. Yea, keep thee far from it, dread it as a
dangerous snare. I will not justify the wicked - That is, I will condemn
him that unjustly condemns others.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p4">9. Thou shalt not oppress the stranger - Though aliens
might not inherit lands among them; yet they must have justice done
them. It was an instance of the equity of our law, that if an alien be
tried for any crime except treason, the one half of his jury, if he
desire it, shall be foreigners; a kind provision that strangers may not
be oppressed. For ye know the heart of a stranger - You know something
of the griefs and fears of a stranger by sad experience.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p5">10. The institution of the sabbatical year was
designed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p6">1. To shew what a plentiful land that was,
into which God was bringing them, that so numerous a people could have
rich maintenance out of the products of so small a country, without
foreign trade, and yet could spare the increase of every seventh
year.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p7">2. To teach them a confidence in the Divine
Providence, while they did their duty, That as the sixth day's manna
served for two days meat, so the sixth year's increase should serve for
two years subsistence.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p8">13. In all things that I have said unto you be
circumspect - We are in danger of missing our way on the right hand and
on the left, and it is at our peril if we do, therefore we have need to
look about us. A man may ruin himself through mere carelessness, but he
cannot save himself without great care and circumspection; particularly
since idolatry was a sin they were much addicted to, and would be
greatly tempted to, they must endeavour to blot out the remembrance of
the gods of the heathen, and must disuse all their superstitious forms
of speech, and never mention them but with detestation. In Christian
schools and academies (for it is in vain to think of re-forming the
play-houses) it were to be wished that the names and stories of the
heathen deities or demons rather were not so commonly and familiarly
used.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p9">14. The Passover, Pentecost, and feast of Tabernacles, in
spring, summer, and autumn, were the three times appointed for their
attendance; not in winter, because travelling was then uncomfortable;
nor in the midst of their harvest.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p10">17. All thy males - All that were of competent years, and
health and strength, and at their own disposal. 'Tis probable, servants
were exempt: for none was to appear without an offering: but most of
these had nothing to offer.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p11">19. Some of the Gentiles, at the end of their harvest,
seethed a kid in it's dam's milk, and sprinkled that milk-pottage in a
magical way upon their gardens and fields, to make them fruitful. But
Israel must abhor such foolish customs. Is not this rather forbidden, as
having some appearance of cruelty?</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p12">20. Behold, I send an angel before thee - The angel of
the covenant: Accordingly the Israelites in the wilderness are said to
tempt Christ. It is promised that this blessed anger should keep them in
the way, though it lay through a wilderness first, and afterwards
through their enemies country; and thus Christ has prepared a place for
his followers.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p13">21. Beware of him, and obey his voice; provoke him not -
It is at your peril if you do; for my name - My nature, my authority is
in him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p14">25. He shall bless thy bread and thy water - And God's
blessing will make bread and water more refreshing and nourishing, than
a feast of fat things, and wines on the lees, without that blessing. And
I will take sickness away - Either prevent it or remove it. Thy land
shall not be visited with epidemical diseases, which are very dreadful,
and sometimes have laid countries waste.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p15">26. The number of thy days I will fulfill - And they
shall not be cut off in the midst by untimely deaths. Thus hath
godliness the promise of the life that now is.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxiv.ii-p16">27. I will send my fear before thee - And they that fear
will soon flee. Hoseats of hornets also made way for the hosts of
Israel; such mean creatures can God make use of for the chastising of
his people's enemies.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="40.87%" prev="ii.iii.xxiv.ii" next="ii.iii.xxv.i" id="ii.iii.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXIV" id="ii.iii.xxv-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIV" progress="40.87%" prev="ii.iii.xxv" next="ii.iii.xxv.ii" id="ii.iii.xxv.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.i-p1">Moses as mediator between God and Israel, having received
divers laws and ordinances from God in the foregoing chapters, in this
chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxv.i-p2">I. Comes down to the people, acquaints them
with the laws he had received, and takes their consent to those laws,
ver. 3. writes the laws, and reads them to the people, who repeat their
consent, ver. 4, 7. and then by sacrifice, and the sprinkling of blood
ratifies the covenant between them and God, ver. 5, 6, 8.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxv.i-p3">II. He returns to God again, to receive
farther directions. When he was dismissed from his former attendance, he
was ordered to attend again, ver. 1, 2. He did so with seventy of the
elders, to whom God made a discovery of his glory, ver. 9-11. Moses is
ordered up into the mount, ver. 12, 13. the rest are ordered down to the
people, ver. 14. The cloud of glory is seen by all the people on the top
of Mount Sinai, ver. 15-17. and Moses is there with God forty days and
forty nights, ver. 18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIV" progress="40.89%" prev="ii.iii.xxv.i" next="ii.iii.xxvi" id="ii.iii.xxv.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p1">1. Worship ye afar off - Before they came near, they must
worship. Thus we must enter into God's gates with humble and solemn
adorations.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p2">2. And Moses alone shall come near - Being therein a type
of Christ, who as the high priest entered alone into the most holy
place. In the following verses we have the solemn covenant made between
God and Israel and the exchanging of the ratifications: typifying the
covenant of grace between God and believers through Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p3">3. Moses told the people all the words of the Lord - He
laid before them all the precepts, in the foregoing chapters, and put it
to them, whether they were willing to submit to these laws or no? And
all the people answered, All the words which the Lord hath said we will
do - They had before consented in general to be under God's government;
here they consent in particular to these laws now given.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p4">4. And Moses wrote the words of the Lord - That there
might be no mistake; as God dictated them on the mount, where, it is
highly probable, God taught him the use of letters. These Moses taught
the Israelites, from whom they afterwards travelled to Greece and other
nations. As soon as God had separated to himself a peculiar people, he
governed them by a written word, as he has done ever since, and will do
while the world stands. Pillars according to the number of the tribes -
These were to represent the people, the other party to the covenant; and
we may suppose they were set up over against the altar, and that Moses
as mediator passed to and fro between them. Probably each tribe set up
and knew its own pillar, and their elders stood by it. He then appointed
sacrifices to be offered upon the altar.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p5">6.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p6">1. The blood of the sacrifice which the
people offered was (part of it) sprinkled upon the altar, which
signified the people's dedicating themselves to God, and his honour. In
the blood of the sacrifices, all the Israelites were presented unto God
as living sacrifices, <scripRef passage="Rom. xii. 1" id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Rom|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.12.1">Rom. xii,
1</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p7">2. The blood of the sacrifice which God had
owned and accepted was (the remainder of it) sprinkled, either upon the
people themselves, or upon the pillars that represented them, which
signified God's conferring his favour upon them, and all the fruits of
that favour, and his giving them all the gifts they could desire from a
God reconciled to them, and in covenant with them. This part of the
ceremony was thus explained, Behold the blood of the covenant; see here
how God sealed to you to be a God, and you seal to be to him a people;
his promises to you, and yours to him, are yea and amen. Thus our Lord
Jesus, the Mediator of the new covenant (of whom Moses was a type)
having offered up himself a sacrifice upon the cross, that his blood
might be indeed the blood of the covenant, sprinkled it upon the altar
in his intercession (<scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 12" id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Heb|9|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.12">Heb. ix,
12</scripRef>,) and sprinkles it upon his church by his word and
ordinances, and the influences and operations of the Spirit of promise
by whom we are sealed.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p8">10. They saw the God of Israel - That is, they had some
glimpse of his glory, in light and fire, though they saw no manner of
similitude. They saw the place where the God of Israel stood, so the
seventy, something that came near a similitude, but was not; whatever
they saw it was certainly something of which no image or picture could
be made, and yet enough to satisfy them that God was with them of a
truth. Nothing is described but that which was under his feet, for our
conceptions of God are all below him. They saw not so much as God's
feet, but at the bottom of the brightness they saw (such as they never
saw before or after, and as the foot- stool or pedestal of it) a most
rich and splendid pavement, as it had been of sapphires, azure, or
sky-coloured. The heavens themselves are the pavement of God's palace,
and his throne is above the firmament.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p9">11. Upon the nobles or elders of Israel he laid not his
hand - Though they were men, the splendour of his glory did not
overwhelm them, but it was so moderated (<scripRef passage="Job xxxvi. 9" id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Job|36|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.36.9">Job xxxvi, 9</scripRef>,) and they were so strengthened (<scripRef passage="Dan. x. 19" id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p9.2" parsed="|Dan|10|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.10.19">Dan. x, 19</scripRef>,) that they were able to bear it: nay, though they were
sinful men, and obnoxious to God's justice, yet he did not lay his
avenging hand upon them, as they feared he would. When we consider what
a consuming fire God is, and what stubble we are before him, we shall
have reason to say, in all our approaches to him, It is of the Lord's
mercies we are not consumed. They saw God, and did eat and drink; They
had not only their lives preserved, but their vigour, courage, and
comfort; it cast no damp upon their joy, but rather increased it. They
feasted upon the sacrifice before God, in token of their chearful
consent to the covenant, their grateful acceptance of the benefits of
it, and their communion with God in pursuance of that covenant.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p10">12. Come up to the mount and be there - Expect to
continue there for some time.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p11">13. Joshua was his minister or servant, and it would be a
satisfaction to him to have him with him as a companion during the six
days that he tarried in the mount before God called to him. Joshua was
to be his successor, and therefore thus he was honoured before the
people, and thus he was prepared by being trained up in communion with
God. Joshua was a type of Christ, and (as the learned Bishop Peirson
well observes Moses takes him with him into the mount, because without
Jesus, in whom are hid all the treasures of wisdom and knowledge, there
is no looking into the secrets of heaven, nor approaching the presence
of God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p12">16. A cloud covered the mount six days - A visible token
of God's special presence there, for he so shews himself to us, as at
the same time to conceal himself from us, he lets us know so much as to
assure us of his power and grace, but intimates to us that we cannot
find him out to perfection. During these six days Moses staid waiting
upon the mountain, for a call into the presence- chamber. And on the
seventh day - Probably the sabbath-day, he called unto Moses. Now the
thick cloud opened in the sight of all Israel, and the glory of the Lord
broke forth like devouring fire.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p13">18. Moses went into the midst of the cloud - It was an
extraordinary presence of mind, which the grace of God furnished him
with, else he durst not have ventured into the cloud, especially when it
broke out in devouring fire. And Moses was in the mount forty days and
forty nights - It should seem the six days, were not part of the forty;
for during those six days, Joshua was with Moses, who did eat of the
manna, and drink of the brook mentioned, <scripRef passage="Deut. ix. 21" id="ii.iii.xxv.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Deut|9|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.9.21">Deut. ix, 21</scripRef>, and while they were together, it is probable Moses did eat
and drink with him; but when Moses was called into the midst of the
cloud, he left Joshua without, who continued to eat and drink daily
while he waited for Moses's return, but from thenceforward Moses
fasted.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="41.01%" prev="ii.iii.xxv.ii" next="ii.iii.xxvi.i" id="ii.iii.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXV" id="ii.iii.xxvi-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.25" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxvi-p0.2">XXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXV" progress="41.01%" prev="ii.iii.xxvi" next="ii.iii.xxvi.ii" id="ii.iii.xxvi.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.i-p1">At this chapter begins an account of the instructions God
gave Moses for erecting and furnishing the tabernacle. Here are,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxvi.i-p2">I. Orders given for a collection to be made
among the people, ver. 1-9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxvi.i-p3">II. Particular instructions,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xxvi.i-p4">1. Concerning the ark of the covenant, ver.
10-22.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xxvi.i-p5">2. The table of shew-bread, ver. 23-30.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xxvi.i-p6">3. The golden candlestick, ver. 31-40.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXV" progress="41.02%" prev="ii.iii.xxvi.i" next="ii.iii.xxvii" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p1">1. Doubtless when Moses went into the midst of the cloud,
and abode there so long, he saw and heard glorious things, but they were
things which were not lawful or possible to utter; and therefore, in the
records he kept of the transactions there, he saith nothing to satisfy
curiosity, but writes that only which he was to speak to the children of
Israel. Probably there never was any house or temple built for sacred
uses, before this tabernacle was erected by Moses. In this God kept his
court, as Israel's king, and it was intended for a sign or token of his
presence, that while they had that in the midst of them they might never
again ask, Is the Lord among us or not? And because in the wilderness
they dwelt in tents, even this royal palace was ordered to be a
tabernacle too, that it might move with them. And these holy places made
with hands were the figures of the true, <scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 24" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Heb|9|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.24">Heb. ix, 24</scripRef>. The gospel-church is the true tabernacle which the Lord
pitched, and not man, <scripRef passage="Heb. viii. 2" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Heb|8|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.8.2">Heb. viii, 2</scripRef>. The body of Christ, in and by which he made atonement, was
the greater and more perfect tabernacle, <scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 11" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p1.3" parsed="|Heb|9|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.11">Heb. ix, 11</scripRef>. The Word was made flesh, and dwelt among us, as in a
tabernacle.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p2">2. Speak unto the children of Israel that they bring me
an offering - This offering was to be given willingly, and with the
heart. It was not prescribed to them what or how much they must give,
but it was left to their generosity, that they might shew their goodwill
to the house of God, and the offices thereof.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p3">4. Blue, and purple, and scarlet - Materials of those
colours.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p4">5. Shittim-wood - A kind of wood growing in Egypt and the
deserts of Arabia, very durable and precious.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p5">8. A sanctuary - A place of public and solemn worship;
that I may dwell among them. Not by my essence, which is everywhere; but
by my grace and glorious operations.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p6">9. According to all that I shew thee - God shewed him an
exact plan of it in little, which he must conform to in all points. And
God did not only shew him the model, but gave him also particular
directions how to frame the tabernacle, according to that model, in all
the parts of it. When Moses was to describe the creation of the world,
tho' it be such a stately and curious fabrick, yet he gave a very short
and general account of it; but when he comes to describe the tabernacle,
he doth it with the greatest niceness and accuracy imaginable: for God's
church and instituted religion is more precious to him than all the rest
of the world. And the scriptures were written not to describe to us the
works of nature, (a general view of which is sufficient to lead us to
the knowledge of the Creator,) but to acquaint us with the methods of
grace, and those things which are purely matters of Revelation.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p7">10. The ark was a chest or coffer, in which the two
tables of the law, written with the finger of God, were to be deposited.
If the Jewish cubit was, as some learned men compute three inches longer
than our half-yard, (twenty one inches in all) this chest or cabinet was
about fifty-two inches long, thirty-one broad and thirty one deep; it
was overlaid within and without with thin plates of gold; it had a
crown, or cornish of gold round it; rings and staves to carry it with;
and in it he must put the testimony. The tables of the law are called
the testimony, because God did in them testify his will; his giving them
that law was in token of his favour to them, and their acceptance of it
was in token of their subjection to him. This law was a testimony to
them to direct them in their duty, and would be a testimony against them
if they transgressed. The ark is called the ark of the testimony, chap.
xxx, 6, and the tabernacle, the tabernacle of the testimony, <scripRef passage="Num. x. 11" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Num|10|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.10.11">Num. x, 11</scripRef>. The tables of the law were carefully preserved in the ark,
to teach us to make much of the word of God, and to hide it in our
inmost thoughts, as the ark was placed in the holy of holies. It
intimates likewise the care which divine providence ever did, and ever
will take to preserve the records of divine Rev. in the church, so that
even in the latter days there shall be seen in his temple the ark of his
testament. See <scripRef passage="Rev. xi. 19" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Rev|11|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.11.19">Rev. xi, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p8">17. The mercy-seat was the covering of the ark, made
exactly to fit the dimensions of it. This propitiatory covering, as it
might well be translated, was a type of Christ the great propitiation,
whose satisfaction covers our transgressions, and comes between us and
the curse we deserve.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p9">18. The cherubim (Cherubim is the plural of Cherub, not
Cherubims) were fixed to the mercy-seat, and of a piece with it, and
spread their wings over it. It is supposed these were designed to
represent the holy angels, (who always attend the Shechinah, or divine
majesty,) not by any effigies of an angel, but some emblem of the
angelical nature, probably one or more of those four faces spoken of <scripRef passage="Ezek. i. 10" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Ezek|1|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.1.10">Ezek. i, 10</scripRef>. Whatever the faces were, they looked one towards another,
and both downwards towards the ark, while their wings were stretched out
so as to touch one another. It notes their attendance upon the Redeemer,
their readiness to do his will, their presence in the assemblies of
saints, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxviii. 17" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p9.2" parsed="|Ps|68|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.68.17">Psalm lxviii, 17</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="1 Cor. xi. 10" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p9.3" parsed="|1Cor|11|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.11.10">1 Cor. xi, 10</scripRef>, and their desire to look into the mysteries of the gospel,
which they diligently contemplate, <scripRef passage="1 Pet. i. 12" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p9.4" parsed="|1Pet|1|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.1.12">1 Pet. i, 12</scripRef>. God is said to dwell or sit between the cherubim, on the
mercy-seat, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxx. 1" id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p9.5" parsed="|Ps|80|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.80.1">Psalm lxxx, 1</scripRef>, and from thence he here promiseth for the future to meet
with Moses, and to commune with him. Thus he manifests himself, willing
to keep up communion with us, by the mediation of Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p10">23. This table was to stand not in the holy of holies,
(nothing was in that but the ark with its appurtenances) but in the
outer part of the tabernacle, called the sanctuary or holy place. This
table was to be always furnished with the shew-bread, or bread of faces,
twelve loaves, one for each tribe, set in two rows, six in a row. As the
ark signified God's being present with them, so the twelve loaves
signified their being presented to God. This bread was designed to be, a
thankful acknowledgment of God's goodness to them in giving them their
daily bread, a token of their communion with God; this bread on God's
table being made of the same corn as the bread on their own tables. And
a type of the spiritual provision which is made in the church, by the
gospel of Christ, for all that are made priests to our God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvi.ii-p11">31. This candlestick had many branches drawn from the
main shaft, which had not only bowls to put the oil and the kindled wick
in for necessity, but knops made in the form of a pomegranate and
flowers for ornament. The tabernacle had no windows, all its light was
candle-light, which notes the comparative darkness of that dispensation,
while the sun of righteousness was not as yet risen, nor had the
day-star from on high visited his church. Yet God left not himself
without witness, nor them without instruction; the commandment was a
lamp, and the law a light, and the prophets were branches from that
lamp, which gave light in their several ages. The church is still dark,
as the tabernacle was, in comparison with what it will be in heaven: but
the word of God is the candlestick, a light burning in a dark place.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="41.14%" prev="ii.iii.xxvi.ii" next="ii.iii.xxvii.i" id="ii.iii.xxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXVI" id="ii.iii.xxvii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.26" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxvii-p0.2">XXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVI" progress="41.14%" prev="ii.iii.xxvii" next="ii.iii.xxvii.ii" id="ii.iii.xxvii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxvii.i-p1">Moses here receives instructions,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxvii.i-p2">I. Concerning the inner curtains of the
tabernacle, ver. 1-6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxvii.i-p3">II. Concerning the outer curtains, ver.
7-13.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxvii.i-p4">III. Concerning the cover which was to
secure it from the weather, ver. 14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxvii.i-p5">IV. Concerning the boards which were to
support the curtains, ver. 15-30.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxvii.i-p6">V. The partition between the holy place and
the most holy, ver. 31-35.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxvii.i-p7">VI. The veil for the door, ver. 36-37.
These particulars seem of little use to us now, yet having been of great
use to Moses and Israel, and God having thought fit to preserve to us
the remembrance of them, we ought not to overlook them.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVI" progress="41.16%" prev="ii.iii.xxvii.i" next="ii.iii.xxviii" id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p1">1. The curtains were to be embroidered with cherubim, to
intimate that the angels of God pitched their tents round about the
church, <scripRef passage="Psalm xxxiv. 7" id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Ps|34|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.34.7">Psalm xxxiv, 7</scripRef>. As there were cherubim over the mercy-seat, so there were
round the tabernacle. There were to be two hangings, five breadths to
each, sewed together, and the two hangings coupled together with golden
clasps or tacks, so that it might be all one tabernacle, ver. 6. Thus
the churches of Christ, though they are many, yet are one, being fitly
joined together in holy love and by the unity of the Spirit, so growing
into one holy temple in the Lord. This tabernacle was very strait and
narrow, but at the preaching of the gospel, the church is bid to enlarge
the place of her tent, and to stretch forth her curtains, <scripRef passage="Isaiah liv. 2" id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Isa|54|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.54.2">Isaiah liv, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p2">14. Badger skins - So we translate it, but it should
rather seem to have been some strong sort of leather, (but very fine)
for we read of the best sort of shoes made of it. <scripRef passage="Ezek. xvi. 10" id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Ezek|16|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.16.10">Ezek. xvi, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p3">15. Very particular directions are here given about the
boards of the tabernacle, which were to bear up the curtains. These had
tenons which fell into the mortaises that were made for them in silver
bases. The boards were coupled together with gold rings at top and
bottom, and kept firm with bars that run through golden staples in every
board. Thus every thing in the tabernacle was very splendid, agreeable
to that infant state of the church, when such things were proper to
possess the minds of the worshippers with a reverence of the divine
glory. In allusion to this, the new Jerusalem is said to be of pure
gold, <scripRef passage="Rev. xxi. 18" id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Rev|21|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.21.18">Rev. xxi, 18</scripRef>. But the builders of the gospel church said, Silver and gold
have we none; and yet the glory of their building far exceeded that of
the tabernacle.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p4">31. The veils are here ordered to be made, one for a
partition between the holy place and the most holy, which not only
forbad any to enter, but so much as to look into the holiest of all.
Under that dispensation divine grace was veiled, but now we behold it
with open face. The apostle tells us, this veil, intimated that the
ceremonial law could not make the comers thereunto perfect. The way into
the holiest was not made manifest while the first tabernacle was
standing; life and immortality lay concealed till they were brought to
light by the gospel, which was therefore signified by the rending of
this veil at the death of Christ. We have now boldness to enter into the
holiest in all acts of devotion by the blood of Jesus; yet such as
obliges us to a holy reverence, and a humble sense of our distance.
Another veil was for the outward door of the tabernacle. Through this
the priests went in every day to minister in the holy-place, but not the
people, <scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 6" id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Heb|9|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.6">Heb. ix, 6</scripRef>. This veil was all the defense the tabernacle had against
thieves and robbers, which might easily be broken through, for it could
be neither locked nor bared, and the abundance of wealth in it, one
would think, might be a temptation. But by leaving it thus exposed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p5">1. The priests and Levites would be so much
the more obliged to keep a strict watch upon it: and,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxvii.ii-p6">2. God would shew his care of his church on
earth, though it be weak and defenseless, and continually exposed. A
curtain shall be (if God please to make it so) as strong a defense, as
gates of brass and bars of iron.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="41.21%" prev="ii.iii.xxvii.ii" next="ii.iii.xxviii.i" id="ii.iii.xxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXVII" id="ii.iii.xxviii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.27" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxviii-p0.2">XXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVII" progress="41.21%" prev="ii.iii.xxviii" next="ii.iii.xxviii.ii" id="ii.iii.xxviii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxviii.i-p1">In this chapter directions are given,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxviii.i-p2">I. Concerning the brazen altar, ver.
1-8.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxviii.i-p3">II. Concerning the court of the tabernacle,
ver. 9-19.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxviii.i-p4">III. Concerning the oil for the lamp, ver.
20-21.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVII" progress="41.22%" prev="ii.iii.xxviii.i" next="ii.iii.xxix" id="ii.iii.xxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxviii.ii-p1">1. As God intended in the tabernacle to manifest his
presence among his people, so there they were to pay their devotions to
him; not in the tabernacle itself, into that only the priests entered as
God's domestic servants, but in the court before the tabernacle, where,
as common subjects they attended. There an altar was ordered so be set
up, to which they must bring their sacrifices; and this altar was to
sanctify their gifts; from hence they were to present their services to
God, as from the mercy-seat he gave his oracles to them; and thus a
communion was settled between God and Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxviii.ii-p2">2. The horns of it, were for ornament and for use; the
sacrifices were bound with cords to the horns of the altar, and to them
malefactors fled for refuge.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxviii.ii-p3">4. The grate was set into the hollow of the altar, about
the middle of it, in which the fire was kept, and the sacrifice burnt;
it was made of net-work like a sieve, and hung hollow, that the fire
might burn the better, and that the ashes might fall through. Now, this
brazen altar was a type of Christ dying to make atonement for our sins.
Christ sanctified himself for his church as their altar, <scripRef passage="John xvii. 19" id="ii.iii.xxviii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|John|17|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.17.19">John xvii, 19</scripRef>, and by his mediation sanctifies the daily services of his
people. To the horns of this altar poor sinners fly for refuge, and are
safe in virtue of the sacrifice there offered.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxviii.ii-p4">9. Before the tabernacle there was to be a court,
enclosed with hangings of fine linen. This court, according to the
common computation, was 50 yards long, and 25 broad. Pillars were set up
at convenient distances, in sockets of brass, the pillars filleted with
silver, and silver tenterhooks in them, on which the linen hangings were
fastened: the hanging which served for the gate was finer than the rest.
This court was a type of the church, enclosed, and distinguished from
the rest of the world; the inclosure supported by pillars, noting the
stability of the church hung with the clean linen, which is said to be
the righteousness of saints, <scripRef passage="Rev. xix. 8" id="ii.iii.xxviii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Rev|19|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.19.8">Rev. xix,
8</scripRef>. Yet this court would contain but a few worshippers; thanks
be to God, now the inclosure is taken down; and there is room for all
that in every place call on the name of Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxviii.ii-p5">20. We read of the candlestick in the 25th chapter; here
is order given for the keeping of the lamps constantly burning in it.
The pure oil signified the gifts and graces of the Spirit, which are
communicated to all believers from Christ the good olive, of whose
fulness we receive, <scripRef passage="Zech. iv. 11, 12" id="ii.iii.xxviii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Zech|4|11|4|12" osisRef="Bible:Zech.4.11-Zech.4.12">Zech. iv, 11,
12</scripRef>. The priests were to light the lamps, and to tend them; to
cause the lamp to burn always, night and day. Thus it is the work of
ministers to preach and expound the scriptures, which are as a lamp to
enlighten the church. This is to be a statute forever, that the lamps
of the word be lighted as duly as the incense of prayer and praise is
offered.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVIII" progress="41.27%" prev="ii.iii.xxviii.ii" next="ii.iii.xxix.i" id="ii.iii.xxix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXVIII" id="ii.iii.xxix-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|28|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.28" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxix-p0.2">XXVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVIII" progress="41.27%" prev="ii.iii.xxix" next="ii.iii.xxix.ii" id="ii.iii.xxix.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.i-p1">In this and the following chapter care is taken about the
priests that were to minister in this holy place. In this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxix.i-p2">I. He pitcheth upon the persons who should
be his servants, ver. 1.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxix.i-p3">II. He appoints their livery; their work
was holy, and so must their garments be, and answerable to the glory of
the house which was now to be erected, ver. 2-5. (1.) He appoints the
garments of his head-servant, the high-priest,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xxix.i-p4">1. An ephod and girdle, ver. 6-14.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xxix.i-p5">2. A breast-plate of judgement, ver. 16-29.
in which must be put the Urim and Thummim, ver. 30.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xxix.i-p6">3. The robe of the ephod, ver. 31-35.</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.iii.xxix.i-p7">4. The mitre, ver. 36-39. (2.) The garments
of the inferior priests, ver. 40-43</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVIII" progress="41.28%" prev="ii.iii.xxix.i" next="ii.iii.xxx" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p1">1. Aaron and his sons - Hitherto every master of a family
was priest to his own family. But now the families of Israel began to be
incorporated into a nation, and a tabernacle of the congregation was to
be erected, as a visible center of their unity, it was requisite there
should be a publick priesthood instituted. Moses, who had hitherto
officiated, and is therefore reckoned among the priests of the Lord, <scripRef passage="Psalm xcix. 6" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Ps|99|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.99.6">Psalm xcix, 6</scripRef>, had enough to do as their prophet, to consult the oracle
for them, and as their prince, to judge among them. Nor was he desirous
to ingross all the honours to himself, or to entail that of the
priesthood, which alone was hereditary, upon his own family; but was
very well pleased to see his brother Aaron invested with this office,
and his sons after him; while (how great soever he was) his sons after
him would be but common Levites. It is an instance of the humility of
that great man, and an evidence of his sincere regard to the glory of
God, that he had so little regard to the preferment of his own family.
Aaron, that had humbly served as a prophet to his younger brother Moses,
and did not decline the office, is now advanced to be a priest to God.
God had said to Israel in general, that they should be to him a kingdom
of priests; but because it was requisite that those who ministered at
the altar should give themselves wholly to the service, God here chose
from among them one to be a family of priests, the father and his four
sons; and from Aaron's loins descended all the priests of the Jewish
church, whom we read of both in the Old Testament and in the New.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p2">2. The priests garments were made for glory and beauty -
Some of the richest materials were to be provided, and the belt artists
employed in making them, whose skill God, by a special gift, would
improve to a very high degree. Eminency, even in common arts, is a gift
of God; it comes from him, and, ought to be used for him. The garments
appointed were, (1.) Four, which both the high-priest and the inferior
priests wore, viz. The linen breeches, the linen coat, the linen girdle
which fastened it to them, and the bonnet; that which the high-priest
wore is called a mitre. (2.) Four more which were peculiar to the
high-priest, the ephod, with the curious girdle of it, the breast-plate
of judgment, the long robe, and the golden plate on his forehead. These
glorious garments, were appointed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p3">1. That the priests themselves might be
minded of the dignity of their office.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p4">2. That the people might thereby be
possessed with a holy reverence of that God whose ministers appeared in
such grandeur.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p5">3. That the priests might be types of
Christ, and of all Christians who have the beauty of holiness put upon
them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p6">6. The ephod, was the outmost garment of the high-priest;
linen ephods were worn by the inferior priests, but this, which the
high- priest wore, was called a golden ephod, because there was a great
deal of gold woven into it. It was a short coat without sleeves,
buttoned close to him with a curious girdle of the same stuff. The
shoulder pieces were buttoned together with two precious stones set in
gold, one on each shoulder. In allusion to this, Christ our high priest
appeared to John, girt about the paps with a golden girdle, such as was
the curious girdle of the ephod, <scripRef passage="Rev. i. 13" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Rev|1|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.1.13">Rev. i,
13</scripRef>. Righteousness is the girdle of his loins. He is girt with
strength for the work of our salvation. And as Aaron had the names of
all Israel upon his shoulders in precious stones, so He presents to
himself and to his Father a glorious church, <scripRef passage="Eph. v. 27" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Eph|5|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.5.27">Eph. v, 27</scripRef>. He bears them before the Lord for a memorial, in token of
his appearing before God as the representative of all Israel, and an
advocate for them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p7">11. Ouches - Hollow places, such as are made in gold
rings, to receive and hold the precious stones.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p8">15. The most considerable of the ornaments of the high
priest was this breast-plate, a rich piece of cloth curiously wrought
with gold and purple, two spans long, and a span broad; so that, being
doubled, it was a span square. In this breast-plate, the tribes of
Israel were recommended to God's favour in twelve precious stones. Some
question whether Levi had a precious stone with his name on or no; if
not Ephraim and Manasseh were reckoned distinct, as Jacob had said they
should be, and the high priest himself being head of the tribe of Levi,
sufficiently represented that tribe. Aaron was to bear their names for a
memorial before the Lord continually, being ordained for men, to
represent them in things pertaining to God; herein typifying our great
High Priest, who always appears in the presence of God for us. The name
of each tribe was engraven in a precious stone, to signify how precious,
in God's sight, believers are, and how honourable, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xliii. 4" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Isa|43|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.43.4">Isaiah xliii, 4</scripRef>. The high priest had the names of the tribes both on his
shoulders and on his breast, noting both the power and the love with
which our Lord Jesus interceeds for us. How near should Christ's name
lie to our hearts, since he is pleased to lay our names so near his? And
what a comfort is it to us, in all our addresses to God, that the great
High Priest of our profession has the names of all his Israel upon his
breast, before the Lord, for a memorial, presenting them to God?</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p9">30. The Urim and Thummim - By which the will of God was
made known in doubtful cases, was put in this breast-plate, which is
therefore called the breast-plate of judgment. Urim and Thummim signify
light and integrity: many conjectures there are among the learned what
they were: we have no reason to think they were any thing that Moses was
to make, more than what was before ordered; so that either God made them
himself, and gave them to Moses, for him to put into the breast-plate
when other things were prepared; or, no more is meant but a declaration
of the further use of what was already ordered to be made. The words may
be read thus, And thou shalt give, or add, to the breast-plate of
judgment, the illuminations and perfections, and they shall be upon the
heart of Aaron - That is, he shall be endued with a power of knowing and
making known the mind of God in all difficult cases relating either to
the civil or ecclesiastical state. Their government was a theocracy; God
was their king, the high priest was, under God, their ruler, this Urim
and Thummim were his cabinet council: probably Moses wrote upon the
breast-plate, or wove into it, these words, Urim and Thummim, to
signify, that the high-priest, having on him this breast-plate, and
asking council of God in any emergency, should be directed to those
measures, which God would own. If he were standing before the ark,
probably he received instructions from off the mercy-seat, as Moses did,
chap. xxv, 22. If he were at a distance from the ark, as Abiathar was
when he inquired of the Lord for David, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxiii. 6" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p9.1" parsed="|1Sam|23|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.23.6">1 Sam. xxiii, 6</scripRef>, then the answer was given either by a voice from heaven, or
by an impulse upon the mind of the high priest, which last is perhaps
intimated in that expression, he shall bear the judgment of the children
of Israel upon his heart. This oracle was of great use to Israel, Joshua
consulted it. <scripRef passage="Num. xxvii. 21" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p9.2" parsed="|Num|27|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.27.21">Num. xxvii, 21</scripRef>, and it is likely, the Judges after him. It was lost in the
captivity, and never retrieved after. It was a shadow of good things to
come, and the substance is Christ. He is our oracle; by him God in these
last days, makes known himself and his mind to us. Divine Revelation
centers in him, and comes to us through him; he is the light, the true
light, the faithful witness; and from him we receive the Spirit of
truth, who leads into all truth. The joining of the breast-plate to the
ephod notes, that his prophetical office was founded on his priesthood;
and it was by the merit of his death that he purchased this honour for
himself, and this favour for us. It was the Lamb that had been slain
that was worthy to take the book and to open the seals. <scripRef passage="Rev. v. 9" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p9.3" parsed="|Rev|5|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.5.9">Rev.
v, 9</scripRef>. The judgment - The breast-plate of judgment: That
breast-plate which declared the judgment or mind of God to the
Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p10">31. The robe of the ephod - This was next under the
ephod, and reached down to the knees, without sleeves, and was put on
over their head, having holes on the sides to put the arms through, or,
as Maimonides describes it, was not sewn together on the sides at all.
The hole on the top through which the head was put was carefully bound
about, that it might not tear in the putting on. The bells gave notice
to the people in the outer court, when he went into the holy place to
burn incense, that they might then apply themselves to their devotions
at the same time, <scripRef passage="Luke i. 10" id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Luke|1|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1.10">Luke i, 10</scripRef>, in token of their concurrence with him, and their hopes of
the ascent of their prayers to God in the virtue of the incense he
offered. Aaron must come near to minister in the garments that were
appointed him, that he die not. 'Tis at his peril if he attend otherwise
than according to the institution.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p11">32. An habergeon - A coat of armour.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p12">33. Pomegranates - The figures of Pomegranates, but flat
and embroidered.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p13">36. On the golden plate fixed upon Aaron's forehead, like
an half coronet, reaching, as the Jews say, from ear to ear, must be
engraven, Holiness to the Lord - Aaron must hereby be minded, that God
is holy, and that his priests must be holy. The high priest must be
consecrated to God, and so must all his ministrations. All that attend
in God's house must have holiness to the Lord engraven upon their
foreheads, that is, they must be holy, devoted to the Lord, and
designing his glory in all they do. This must appear in their forehead,
in an open profession of their relation to God, as those that are not
ashamed to own it, and in a conversation answerable to it. It must
likewise be engraven like the engravings of a signet, so deep, so
durable; not painted, so as it may he washed off, but sincere and
lasting.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p14">38. Aaron must have this upon his forehead, that he may
bear the iniquity of the holy things, and that they may be accepted
before the Lord - Herein he was a type of Christ, the great Mediator
between God and man. Thro' him what is amiss in our services is
pardoned: even this would be our ruin, if God should enter into judgment
with us: but Christ our high priest bears this iniquity; bears it for
us, so as to bear it from us. Thro' him likewise what is good is
accepted; our persons, our performances are pleasing to God upon the
account of Christ's intercession, and not otherwise. His being holiness
to the Lord, recommends all those to the divine favour that believe in
him. Having such a high priest, we come boldly to the throne of
grace.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p15">39. The embroidered coat of fine linen - Was the
innermost of the priestly garments, it reached to the feet, and the
sleeves to the wrists, and was bound to the body with a girdle or sash
of needlework. The mitre or diadem was of linen, such as kings anciently
wore in the east, typifying the kingly office of Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxix.ii-p16">43. It shall be a statute forever - That is, It is to
continue as long as the priesthood continues. And it is to have its
perpetuity in the substance, of which these things were the shadows.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIX" progress="41.48%" prev="ii.iii.xxix.ii" next="ii.iii.xxx.i" id="ii.iii.xxx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXIX" id="ii.iii.xxx-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|29|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.29" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxx-p0.2">XXIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIX" progress="41.48%" prev="ii.iii.xxx" next="ii.iii.xxx.ii" id="ii.iii.xxx.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.i-p1">Orders are given in this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxx.i-p2">I. Concerning the consecration of the
priests, and the sanctification of the altar, ver. 1-37.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxx.i-p3">II. Concerning the daily sacrifice, ver.
38-41. To which gracious promises are annexed, ver. 42-46.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIX" progress="41.48%" prev="ii.iii.xxx.i" next="ii.iii.xxxi" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p1">4. They were to be consecrated at the door of the
tabernacle - God was pleased to dwell in the tabernacle, the people
attending in the courts, so that the door between the court and the
tabernacle was the fittest place for them to be consecrated in, who were
to mediate between God and man, and to stand between both, and lay their
hands (as it were) upon both. Here they were to be washed, signifying
that they must be clean who bear the vessels of the Lord, <scripRef passage="Isaiah lii. 11" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Isa|52|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.52.11">Isaiah lii, 11</scripRef>. And they were to be clothed with the holy garments, to
signify that it was not sufficient for them to put away the pollutions
of sin, but they must put on the graces of the Spirit, be clothed with
righteousness, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xxxii, 9. They must be girded, as men prepared and
strengthened for their work; and they must be robed and crowned, as men
that counted their work and office their true honour.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p2">7. The high priest was to be anointed with the holy
anointing oil - That the church might be filled with the sweet favour of
his administrations, and in token of the pouring out of the Spirit upon
him, to qualify him for his work.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p3">10. There must be a sin-offering, to make atonement for
them. The law made them priests that had infirmity; and therefore they
must first offer for their own sin, before they could make atonement for
the people, <scripRef passage="Heb. vii. 27, 28" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Heb|7|27|7|28" osisRef="Bible:Heb.7.27-Heb.7.28">Heb. vii, 27,
28</scripRef>. They were to put their hand on the head of their sacrifice;
confessing that they deserved to die for their own sin, and desiring
that the killing of the beast might be accepted as a vicarious
satisfaction. It was used as other sin-offerings were; only, whereas the
flesh of other sin-offerings was eaten by the priests, in token of the
priests taking away the sin of the people, this was appointed to be all
burnt without the camp, to signify the imperfection of the legal
dispensation, for the sins of the priests themselves could not be taken
away by those sacrifices, but they must expect a better high priest, and
a better sacrifice.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p4">15. There must be a burnt-offering, a ram wholly burnt,
in token of the dedication of themselves wholly to God, as living
sacrifices, kindled with the fire, and ascending in the flame of holy
love. This sin-offering must be offered, and then the burnt- offering,
for till guilt be removed no acceptable service can be performed.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p5">19. There must be a peace-offering; it is called the ram
of consecration, because there was more in this, peculiar to the
occasion, than in the other two. In the burnt-offering God had the glory
of their priesthood, in this they had the comfort of it. And in token of
a mutual covenant between God and them, the blood of this sacrifice was
divided between God and them, part of the blood was sprinkled upon the
altar round about, and part upon them, upon their bodies, and upon their
garments. Thus the benefit of the expiation made by the sacrifice was
applied and assured to them, and their whole selves from head to foot
sanctified to the service of God. The blood was put upon the extreme
parts of the body, to signify, that it was all as it were enclosed and
taken in for God, the tip of the ear, and the great toe not excepted.
And the blood and oil signified the blood of Christ, and the graces of
the Spirit, which constitute and compleat the beauty of holiness, and
recommend us to God. The flesh of the sacrifice, with the meat- offering
annexed to it, was likewise divided between God and them, that (to speak
with reverence) God and they might feast together, in token of
friendship and fellowship.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p6">22. Part of it was to be first waved before the Lord, and
then burnt upon the altar, these were first put into the hands of Aaron
to be waved to and fro in token of their being offered to God, and then
they were to be burnt upon the altar, for the altar was to devour God's
part of the sacrifice. Thus God admitted Aaron and his sons to wait at
his table, taking the meat of his altar from their hands. Here, in a
parenthesis as it were, comes in the law concerning the priests part of
the peace-offerings afterwards, the breast and shoulder, which were now
divided; Moses had the breast, and the shoulder was burnt on the altar
with God's part.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p7">31. The other part of the flesh of the ram, and of the
bread, Aaron and his sons were to eat at the door of the tabernacle, to
signify that he not only called them servants but friends. He supped
with them, and they with him. Their eating of the things wherewith the
atonement was made, signified their receiving the atonement, their
thankful acceptance of the benefit of it, and their joyful communion
with God thereupon.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p8">35. Seven days shalt thou consecrate them - Though all
the ceremonies were performed on the first day, yet, they were not to
look upon their consecration as compleated till the seven days end,
which put a solemnity upon their admission, and a distance between this
and their former state, and obliged them to enter upon their work with a
pause, giving them time to consider the weight of it. This was to be
observed in after ages: he that was to succeed Aaron in the high
priesthood, must put on the holy garments seven days together, in token
of a deliberate advance into his office, and that one sabbath might pass
over him, in his consecration. Every day of the seven, in this first
consecration, a bullock was to be offered for a sin-offering, which was
to intimate, (1.) That though atonement was made, yet they must still
keep up a penitent sense of sin, and often repeat the confession of it.
(2.) That those sacrifices which were thus offered day by day, could not
make the comers there unto perfect, for then they would have ceased to
be offered; <scripRef passage="Heb. x. 1, 2" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Heb|10|1|10|2" osisRef="Bible:Heb.10.1-Heb.10.2">Heb. x, 1, 2</scripRef>. They must therefore expect the bringing in of a better
hope. Now this consecration of the priests was a shadow of good things
to come.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p9">1. Our Lord Jesus is the great high priest
of our profession, called of God to be so consecrated forevermore,
anointed with the Spirit above his fellows, whence he is called Messiah,
the Christ; clothed with the holy garments, even with glory and beauty;
sanctified by his own blood, not that of bullocks and rams.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p10">2. All believers are spiritual priests, to
offer spiritual sacrifices, <scripRef passage="1 Pet. ii. 5" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p10.1" parsed="|1Pet|2|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Pet.2.5">1 Pet. ii, 5</scripRef>, washed in the blood of Christ, and so made to our God
priests, <scripRef passage="Rev. i. 5, 6" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p10.2" parsed="|Rev|1|5|1|6" osisRef="Bible:Rev.1.5-Rev.1.6">Rev. i, 5,
6</scripRef>. They also are clothed with the beauty of holiness, and have
received the anointing, <scripRef passage="1 John ii. 27" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p10.3" parsed="|1John|2|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.2.27">1 John
ii, 27</scripRef>. His blood sprinkled upon the conscience, purgeth it from
dead works, that they may, as priests, serve the living God. The Spirit
of God is called the finger of God (<scripRef passage="Luke xi. 20" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p10.4" parsed="|Luke|11|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.11.20">Luke xi, 20</scripRef>, compared with <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 28" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p10.5" parsed="|Matt|12|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.28">Matt. xii, 28</scripRef>,) and by him the merit of Christ is effectually applied to
our souls, as here Moses with his finger was to put the blood upon
Aaron. It is likewise intimated that gospel ministers are to be solemnly
set apart to the work of the ministry with great deliberation and
seriousness, both in the ordainers, and in the ordained, as those that
are employed in a great work, and intrusted with a great charge.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p11">36. The consecration of the altar, seems to have been
coincident with that of the priests; and the sin-offerings, which were
offered every day for seven days together, had reference to the altar,
as well as the priests. And atonement was made for the altar. The altar
was also sanctified, not only set apart itself to a sacred use, but made
so holy as to sanctify the gifts that were offered upon it, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxiii. 19" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Matt|23|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.23.19">Matt. xxiii, 19</scripRef>. Christ is our altar, for our sakes he sanctified himself,
that we and our performances might be sanctified and recommended to God,
<scripRef passage="John xvii. 19" id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p11.2" parsed="|John|17|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.17.19">John xvii, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p12">38. This daily service, a lamb offered upon the altar
every morning, and every evening, typified the continual intercession
which Christ ever lives to make in the virtue of his satisfaction for
the continual sanctification of his church: though he offered himself
once for all, yet that one offering thus becomes a continual offering.
And this teaches us to offer up to God the spiritual sacrifices of
prayer and praise every day, morning and evening, in humble
acknowledgment of our dependence upon him, and our obligations to
him.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxx.ii-p13">40. A tenth deal, or tenth part of an ephah, is about
three quarts. A hin is five quarts.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXX" progress="41.62%" prev="ii.iii.xxx.ii" next="ii.iii.xxxi.i" id="ii.iii.xxxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXX" id="ii.iii.xxxi-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|30|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.30" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxxi-p0.2">XXX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXX" progress="41.62%" prev="ii.iii.xxxi" next="ii.iii.xxxi.ii" id="ii.iii.xxxi.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.i-p1">Moses in this chapter farther instructed, (1.) Concerning
the altar of incense, ver. 1-10. (2.) Concerning the ransom money, which
the Israelites were to pay when they were numbered, ver. 11-16. (3.)
Concerning the laver of brass, ver. 17-21. (4.) Concerning the anointing
oil, ver. 22-33. (5.) Concerning the incense and perfume, which was to
be burned on the golden altar, ver. 34-38.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXX" progress="41.63%" prev="ii.iii.xxxi.i" next="ii.iii.xxxii" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p1">1. The altar of incense was to be about a yard high, and
half a yard square, with horns at the corners, a golden cornish round
it, with rings and staves of gold for the convenience of carrying it,
ver. 1- 5. It doth not appear that there was any grate to this altar for
the ashes to fall into, that they might be taken away; but when they
burn incense, a golden censer was brought, with coals in it, and placed
upon the altar, and in that censer the incense was burnt, and with it
all the coals were taken away, so that no coals or ashes fell upon the
altar. The altar of incense in Ezekiel's temple is double to what it is
here, <scripRef passage="Ezek. xli. 22" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Ezek|41|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.41.22">Ezek. xli, 22</scripRef>, and it is there called an altar of wood, and there is no
mention of gold, to signify that the incense in gospel times should be
spiritual, the worship plain, and the service of God enlarged. It was
placed before the veil, on the outside of that partition, but before the
mercy-seat, which was within the veil. For though he that ministered at
that altar could not see the mercy-seat, the veil interposing, yet he
must look towards it, and direct his incense that way, to teach us, that
though we cannot with our bodily eyes see the throne of grace, that
blessed mercy-seat, yet we must in prayer by faith set ourselves before
it, direct our prayer and look up.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p2">7. Aaron was to burn sweet incense upon this altar every
morning and every evening, which was intended not only to take away the
ill smell of the flesh that was burnt daily on the brazen altar, but for
the honour of God, and to shew the, acceptableness of his people's
services to him. As by the offerings on the brazen altar satisfaction
was made for what had been done displeasing to God, so by the offering
on this what they did well was, as it were, recommended to the divine
acceptance.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p3">10. This altar was purified with the blood of the
sin-offering put upon the horns of it every year, upon the day of
atonement. See <scripRef passage="Lev. xvi. 18" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Lev|16|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.16.18">Lev. xvi,
18</scripRef>,</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p4">19. The high priest was to take this in his way as he
came out from the holy of holies. This was to intimate, that the sins of
the priests who ministered at this altar, and of the people for whom
they ministered, put a ceremonial impurity upon it, from which it must
be cleansed by the blood of atonement. This altar typified the mediation
of Christ: the brazen altar in the court was a type of Christ dying on
earth; the golden altar in the sanctuary was a type of Christ
interceding in heaven. This altar was before the mercy- seat, for Christ
always appears in the presence of God for us; and his intercession is
unto God of a sweet smelling savour. And it typified the devotions of
the saints, whose prayers are said to be set forth before God as
incense, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xli, 2. As the smoke of the incense ascended, so must
our desires, being kindled with the fire of holy love. When the priest
was burning incense the people were praying, <scripRef passage="Luke i. 10" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p4.2" parsed="|Luke|1|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1.10">Luke i, 10</scripRef>, to signify that prayer is the true incense. This incense
was a perpetual incense, for we must pray always. The lamps were dressed
or lighted at the same time that the incense was burnt, to teach us that
the reading of the scriptures (which are our light and lamp) is a part
of our daily work, and should ordinarily accompany our prayers and
praises. The devotions of sanctified souls are well-pleasing to God, of
a sweet- smelling savour; the prayers of saints are compared to sweet
odours, <scripRef passage="Rev. v. 8" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p4.3" parsed="|Rev|5|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.5.8">Rev. v, 8</scripRef>, but it is the incense which Christ adds to them that makes
them acceptable; and his blood that atones for the guilt which cleaves
to our best services. Yet if the heart and life be not holy, even
incense is an abomination, <scripRef passage="Isaiah i. 13" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p4.4" parsed="|Isa|1|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.1.13">Isaiah i, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p5">11. Perhaps the repetition of those words, the Lord spake
unto Moses, here and afterwards, ver. 17, 22, 34, intimates, that God
did not deliver these precepts to Moses, in a continued discourse, but
with many intermissions, giving him time either to write what was said
to him, or at least to charge his memory with it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p6">12. Some think this refers only to the first numbering of
them, when the tabernacle was set up, and that this tax was to make up
what was wanting in the voluntary contributions. Others think it was to
be always when the people were numbered; and that David offended in not
demanding it when he numbered the people. But many of the Jewish writers
are of opinion, it was to be an annual tribute; only it was begun when
Moses first numbered the people. This was that tribute-money which
Christ paid lest he should offend his adversaries. The tribute to be
paid was half a shekel, about fifteen-pence of our money. In other
offerings men were to give according to their ability, but this, which
was the ransom of the soul, must be alike for all; for the rich have as
much need of Christ as the poor, and the poor are as welcome to him as
the rich. And this was to be paid as a ransom of the soul, that there
might be no plague among them - Hereby they acknowledged that they
received their lives from God, that they had forfeited their lives to
him, and that they depended upon his power and patience for the
continuance of them; and thus they did homage to the God of their lives,
and deprecated those plagues which their sins had deserved. This money
was employed in the service of the tabernacle; with it they bought
sacrifices, flour, incense wine, oil, fuel, salt, priests garments, and
all other things which the whole congregation was interested in.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p7">18. The laver, or font was a large vessel, that would
contain a good quantity of water. The foot of brass, it is supposed, was
so contrived as to receive the water, which was let out of the laver, by
spouts or cocks. They then had a laver for the priests only to wash in,
but to us now there is a fountain opened for Judah and Jerusalem, <scripRef passage="Zech. xiii. 1" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Zech|13|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.13.1">Zech. xiii, 1</scripRef>, an inexhaustible fountain of living water, so that it is
our own fault if we remain in our pollution. Aaron and his sons were to
wash their hands and feet at this laver every time they went in to
minister. For this purpose clean water was put into the laver, fresh
every day. Though they washed themselves ever so clean at their own
houses, that would not serve, they must wash at the laver. This was
designed, to teach them purity in all their ministrations, and to
possess them with a reverence of God's holiness, and a dread of the
pollutions of sin. They must not only wash and be made clean when they
were first consecrated, but they must wash and be kept clean, whenever
they went in to minister. He only shall stand in God's holy place that
hath clean hands and a pure heart, <scripRef passage="Psalm xxiv. 3, 4" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Ps|24|3|24|4" osisRef="Bible:Ps.24.3-Ps.24.4">Psalm xxiv, 3, 4</scripRef>. And it was to teach us, who are daily to attend upon God,
daily to renew our repentance for sin, and our believing application of
the blood of Christ to our souls for remission.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p8">23. Interpreters are not agreed concerning these
ingredients: the spices, which were in all near half a hundred weight,
were to be infused in the oil, which was to be about five or six quarts,
and then strained out, leaving an admirable smell in the oil. With this
oil God's tent and all the furniture of it were to be anointed; it was
to be used also in the consecration of the priests. It was to be
continued throughout their generations, ver. 31. Solomon was anointed
with it, <scripRef passage="1 Kings i. 39" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|1Kgs|1|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.1.39">1 Kings i, 39</scripRef>, and some other of the kings, and all the high priests, with
such a quantity of it, as that it ran down to the skirts of the
garments; and we read of the making it up, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ix. 30" id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p8.2" parsed="|1Chr|9|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.9.30">1 Chron. ix, 30</scripRef>. Yet all agree that in the second temple there was none of
this holy oil, which was probably owing to a notion they had, that it
was not lawful to make it up; Providence over-ruling that want as a
presage of the better unction of the Holy Ghost in gospel-times, the
variety of whose gifts was typified by these sweet ingredients.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxi.ii-p9">34. The incense which was burned upon the golden altar
was prepared of sweet spices likewise, though not so rare and rich as
those which the anointing oil was compounded of. This was prepared once
a year, (the Jews say) a pound for each day of the year, and three pound
over for the day of atonement. When it was used it was to be beaten very
small; thus it pleased the Lord to bruise the Redeemer, when he offered
himself for a sacrifice of a sweet smelling savour. Concerning both
these preparations the same law is here given, that the like should not
be made for any common use. Thus God would preserve in the peoples minds
a reverence for his own institutions, and teach us not to profane or
abuse any thing whereby God makes himself known.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXI" progress="41.78%" prev="ii.iii.xxxi.ii" next="ii.iii.xxxii.i" id="ii.iii.xxxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXXI" id="ii.iii.xxxii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|31|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.31" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxxii-p0.2">XXXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXI" progress="41.78%" prev="ii.iii.xxxii" next="ii.iii.xxxii.ii" id="ii.iii.xxxii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxii.i-p1">In this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxii.i-p2">I. God appoints what workmen should be
employed in the building and furnishing the tabernacle, ver. 1-11.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxii.i-p3">II. He repeats the law of the sabbath, ver.
12-17.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxii.i-p4">III. He delivers to Moses the two tables of
the testimony, ver. 18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXI" progress="41.79%" prev="ii.iii.xxxii.i" next="ii.iii.xxxiii" id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p1">2. See I have called Bezaleel, the grandson of Hur,
probably that Hur who had helped to hold up Moses's hand, chap. xvii,
10-12, and was at this time in commission with Aaron for the government
of the people in the absence of Moses. Aholiab of the tribe of Dan. is
appointed next to Bezaleel, and partner with him. Hiram, who was the
head-workman in the building of Solomon's temple, was also of the tribe
of Daniel, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. ii. 14" id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|2Chr|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.2.14">2 Chron. ii,
14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p2">3. And I have filled him with the spirit of God; and ver.
6. In the hearts of all that are wise-hearted I have put wisdom. Skill
in common employments is the gift of God; It is he that puts even this
wisdom into the inward parts, <scripRef passage="Job xxxviii. 36" id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Job|38|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.38.36">Job
xxxviii, 36</scripRef>. He teacheth the husbandman discretion, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxviii. 26" id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Isa|28|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.28.26">Isaiah xxviii, 26</scripRef>, and the tradesman too, and he must have the praise of
it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p3">13. It is a sign between me and you - The institution of
the sabbath was a great instance of God's favour, and a sign that he had
distinguished them from all other people: and their religious observance
of it, was a great instance of their duty to him. God, by sanctifying
this day among them, let them know that he sanctified them, and set them
apart for his service, otherwise he would not have revealed to them his
holy sabbaths to be the support of religion among them. The Jews by
observing one day in seven, after six days labour, testified that they
worshipped the God that made the world in six days, and rested the
seventh; and so distinguished themselves from other nations, who having
first lost the sabbath, the memorial of the creation, by degrees lost
the knowledge of the creator, and gave the creature the honour due to
him alone.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p4">14. It is holy unto you - That is, it is designed for
your benefit as well as for God's honour; it shall be accounted holy by
you.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p5">15. It is the sabbath of rest, holy to the Lord - It is
separated from common use, for the service of God; and by the observance
of it we are taught to rest from worldly pursuits, and devote ourselves,
and all we are, have, and can do, to God's glory.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p6">16. It was to be observed throughout their generations,
in every age, for a perpetual covenant - This was to be one of the most
lasting tokens of the covenant between God and Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p7">17. On the seventh day he rested - And as the work of
creation is worthy to be thus commemorated, so the great Creator is
worthy to be thus imitated, by a holy rest the seventh day.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxii.ii-p8">18. These tables of stone, were not prepared by Moses,
but probably by the ministry of angels. They were written with the
finger of God - That is, by his will and power immediately, without the
use of any instrument. They were written in two tables, being designed
to direct us in our duty, towards God, and towards man. And they were
called tables of testimony, because this written law testified the will
of God concerning them, and would be a testimony against them if they
were disobedient.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXII" progress="41.84%" prev="ii.iii.xxxii.ii" next="ii.iii.xxxiii.i" id="ii.iii.xxxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXXII" id="ii.iii.xxxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|32|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.32" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxxiii-p0.2">XXXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXII" progress="41.84%" prev="ii.iii.xxxiii" next="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.i-p1">Here is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.i-p2">I. The sin of Israel, and Aaron
particularly in making the golden calf, ver. 1-4. and worshipping it,
ver. 5, 6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.i-p3">II. The notice which God gave of this to
Moses, who was now in the mount with him, ver. 7, 8. and the sentence of
his wrath against them, ver. 9, 10.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.i-p4">III. The intercession which Moses made for
them, ver. 11, 12, 13. and the prevalency of that intercession, ver
14.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.i-p5">IV. His coming down from the mount, and
being an eye witness of their idolatry, ver. 15-19. in detestation of
which he broke the tables, ver. 19. and burnt the golden calf, ver.
20.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.i-p6">V. The examination of Aaron about it, ver.
21-24.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.i-p7">VI. Execution done upon the ringleaders in
the idolatry, ver. 25- 29.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.i-p8">VII. The further intercession Moses made,
to turn away the wrath of God from them, ver. 30-32. and a reprieve
granted thereupon, reserving them for a further reckoning, ver.
33-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXII" progress="41.85%" prev="ii.iii.xxxiii.i" next="ii.iii.xxxiv" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p1">1. Up, make us gods which shall go before us. They were
weary of waiting for the promised land. They thought themselves detained
too long at Mount Sinai. They had a God that stayed with them, but they
must have a God to go before them to the land flowing with milk and
honey. They were weary of waiting for the return of Moses: As for this
Moses, the man that brought us up out of Egypt, we know not what is
become of him - Observe how slightly they speak of his person, this
Moses: And how suspiciously of his delay, we know not what is become of
him. And they were weary of waiting for a divine institution of
religious worship among them, so they would have a worship of their own
invention, probably such as they had seen among the Egyptians. They say,
make us gods which shall go before us. Gods! How many would they have?
Is not one sufficient? And what good would gods of their own making do
them? They must have such Gods to go before them as could not go
themselves farther than they were carried!</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p2">2. And Aaron said break off the golden ear-rings - We do
not find that he said one word to discountenance their proposal. Some
suppose, that when Aaron bid them break off their ear-rings, he did it
with design to crush the proposal, believing that, though their
covetousness would have let them do it, yet their pride would not have
suffered them to part with them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p3">3. And all the people brake off their ear-rings - Which
Aaron melted down, and, having a mold prepared, poured the melted gold
into it, and then produced it in the shape of an ox or calf, giving it
some finishing strokes with a graving tool.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p4">5. And Aaron built an altar before it, and proclaimed a
feast - A feast of dedication; yet he calls it a feast to Jehovah; for,
as brutish as they were, they did not design to terminate their
adoration in the image; but they made it for a representation of the
true God, whom they intended to worship in and through this image. And
yet this did not excuse them from gross idolatry, no more than it will
excuse the Papists, whose plea it is, that they do not worship the
image, but God by the image; so making themselves just such idolaters as
the worshippers of the golden calf, whose feast was a feast to Jehovah,
and proclaimed to be so, that the most ignorant and unthinking might not
mistake it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p5">6. And they rose up early on the morrow, and offered
sacrifice to this new made deity. And the people sat down to eat and
drink of the remainder of what was sacrificed, and then rose up to play
- To play the fool, to play the wanton. It was strange that any of the
people, especially so great a number of them, should do such a thing.
Had they not, but the other day, in this very place, heard the voice of
the Lord God speaking to them out of the midst of the fire, Thou shalt
not make to thyself any graven image? - Yet They made a calf in Horeb,
the very place where the law was given It was especially strange that
Aaron should be so deeply concerned, should make the calf and proclaim
the feast! Is this Aaron the saint of the Lord! Is this he that had not
only seen, but had been employed in summoning the plagues of Egypt, and
the judgments executed upon the gods of the Egyptians? What! And yet
himself copying out the abandoned idolatries of Egypt? How true is it,
that the law made them priests which had infirmity, and needed first to
offer for their own sins?</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p6">8. They have turned aside quickly - Quickly after the law
was given them, and they had promised to obey it; quickly after God had
done such great things for them, and declared his kind intentions to do
greater.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p7">9. It is a stiff-necked people - Unapt to come under the
yoke of the divine law, averse to all good, and prone to evil, obstinate
to the methods of cure.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p8">10. Let me alone - What did Moses, or what could he do,
to hinder God from consuming them? When God resolves to abandon a
people, and the decree is gone forth, no intercession can prevent it.
But God would thus express the greatness of his displeasure, after the
manner of men, who would have none to interceed for those they resolve
to be severe with. Thus also he would put an honour upon prayer,
intimating, that nothing but the intercession of Moses could save them
from ruin, that he might be a type of Christ, by whose mediation alone
God would reconcile the world unto himself.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p9">11. And Moses besought the Lord his God - If God would
not be called the God of Israel, yet he hoped he might address him as
his own God. Now Moses is standing in the gap to turn away the wrath of
God. <scripRef passage="Psalm cvi. 23" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Ps|106|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.106.23">Psalm cvi, 23</scripRef>. He took the hint which God gave him when he said, Let me
alone, which, though it seemed to forbid his interceding, did really
encourage it, by shewing what power the prayer of faith hath with
God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p10">12. Turn from thy fierce wrath - Not as if he thought God
were not justly angry, but he begs that he would not be so greatly angry
as to consume them. Let mercy rejoice against judgment; repent of this
evil - Change the sentence of destruction into that of correction,
against thy people which thou broughtest up out of Egypt - For whom thou
hast done so great things? Wherefore should the Egyptians say, For
mischief did he bring them out - Israel is dear to Moses, as his
kindred, as his charge; but it is the glory of God that he is most
concerned for. If Israel could perish without any reproach to God's
name, Moses could persuade himself to sit down contented; but he cannot
bear to hear God reflected on; and therefore this he insists upon, Lord,
What will the Egyptians say? They will say, God was either weak, and
could not, or fickle, and would not compleat the salvation he begun.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p11">13. Remember Abraham - Lord, if Israel be cut off, what
will become of the promise?</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p12">14. And the Lord repented of the evil he thought to do -
Though he designed to punish them, yet he would not ruin them. See here,
the power of prayer, God suffers himself to be prevailed with by humble
believing importunity. And see the compassion of God towards poor
sinners, and how ready he is to forgive.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p13">15. On both their sides - Some on one table and some on
the other, so that they were folded together like a book, to be
deposited in the ark.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p14">16. The writing of God - Very probably the first writing
in the world.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p15">19. He saw the calf, and the dancing, and his anger waxed
hot - It is no breach of the law of meekness to shew our displeasure at
wickedness. Those are angry and sin not, that are angry at sin only.
Moses shewed himself angry, both by breaking the tables, and burning the
calf, that he might by these expressions of a strong passion awaken the
people to a sense of the greatness of their sin. He broke the tables
before their eyes, as it is <scripRef passage="Deut. ix. 17" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Deut|9|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.9.17">Deut. ix, 17</scripRef>, that the sight of it might fill them with confusion when
they saw what blessings they had lost. The greatest sign of God's
displeasure against any people is his taking his law from them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p16">20. He burnt the calf - Melted it down, and then filed it
to dust; and that the powder to which it was reduced might he taken
notice of throughout the camp, he strawed it upon the water which they
all drank of. That it might appear that an idol is nothing in the world,
he reduced this to atoms, that it might be as near nothing as could
be.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p17">21. What did this people unto thee - He takes it for
granted that it must needs be something more than ordinary that
prevailed with Aaron to do such a thing? Did they overcome thee by
importunity, and hadst thou so little resolution as to yield to popular
clamour! Did they threaten to stone thee, and couldest not thou have
opposed God's threatenings to theirs?</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p18">23. They said, make us Gods - It is natural to us to
endeavour thus to transfer our guilt. He likewise extenuates his own
share in the sin, as if he had only bid them break off their gold,
intending but to make a hasty essay for the present, and childishly
insinuates that when he cast the gold into the fire, it came out either
by accident, or by the magic art of some of the mixt multitude (as the
Jewish writers dream) in this shape. This was all Aaron had to say for
himself, and he had better have said nothing, for his defense did but
aggravate his offense; and yet as sin did abound, grace did much more
abound.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p19">25. The people were naked - Stript of their armour, and
liable to insults.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p20">26. Then Moses stood in the gate of the camp, the place
of judgment; and said, Who is on the Lord's side? - The idolaters had
set up the golden calf for their standard, and now Moses sets up his in
opposition to them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p21">27. Slay every man his brother - That is, Slay all those
that you know to have been active for the making and worshipping of the
golden calf, though they were your nearest relations or dearest friends.
Yet it should seem they were to slay those only whom they found abroad
in the street of the camp; for it might be hoped that those who were
retired into their tents were ashamed of what they had done.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p22">28. And there fell of the people that day about three
thousand men - Probably these were but few in comparison with the many
that were guilty; but these were the men that headed the rebellion, and
were therefore picked out to be made examples of; for terror to
others.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p23">31. Oh, this people have sinned a great sin - God had
first told him of it, ver. 7, and now he tells God of it by way of
lamentation. He doth not call them God's people, he knew they were
unworthy to be called so, but this people. This treacherous ungrateful
people, they have made them gods of gold.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p24">32. If not - If the decree be gone forth, and there is no
remedy but they must be ruined, blot me, I pray thee out of the book
which thou hast written - That is, out of the book of life. If all
Israel must perish, I am content to perish with them. This expression
may be illustrated from <scripRef passage="Rom. ix. 3" id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p24.1" parsed="|Rom|9|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.9.3">Rom. ix,
3</scripRef>. For I could wish myself to be an anathema from Christ, for
my brethren's sake. Does this imply no more than not enjoying Canaan?
Not that Moses absolutely desired this, but only comparatively expresses
his vehement zeal for God's glory, and love to his people, signifying,
that the very thought of their destruction, and the dishonour of God,
was so intolerable to him, that he rather wishes, if it were possible,
that God would accept of him, as a sacrifice in their stead, and by his
utter destruction, prevent so great a mischief.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p25">33. Whosoever hath sinned, him will I blot out of my book
- The soul that sins shall die, and not the innocent for the guilty.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p26">34. My angel shall go before them - Some created angel
that was employed in the common services of his kingdom, which intimated
that they were not to expect any thing for the future to be done for
them out of the common road of providence. When I visit - Hereafter he
shall see cause to punish them for other sins, I will visit for this
among the rest. From hence the Jews have a saying, that from
hence-forward no judgment fell upon Israel, but there was in it an ounce
of the powder of the golden calf.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii-p27">35. And the Lord plagued the people - Probably by the
pestilence, or some other infectious disease. Thus Moses prevailed for a
mitigation of the punishment, but could not wholly turn away the wrath
of God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIII" progress="42.05%" prev="ii.iii.xxxiii.ii" next="ii.iii.xxxiv.i" id="ii.iii.xxxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXXIII" id="ii.iii.xxxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|33|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.33" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxxiv-p0.2">XXXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXIII" progress="42.05%" prev="ii.iii.xxxiv" next="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii" id="ii.iii.xxxiv.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.i-p1">In this chapter we have a further account of the
mediation of Moses between God and Israel.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiv.i-p2">I. He brings a very humbling message from
God to them, ver. 1, 2, 3, 5. which has a good effect upon then, ver. 4,
6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiv.i-p3">II. He settles a correspondence between God
and them; and both God and the people signify their approbation of that
correspondence, God by descending in a cloudy pillar, and the people by
worshipping at the tent-doors, ver. 7-12.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxiv.i-p4">III. He is earnest with God in prayer, and
prevails. (1.) For a promise of his presence with the people, ver.
12-17. (2.) For a sight of his glory for himself, ver. 18-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXIII" progress="42.06%" prev="ii.iii.xxxiv.i" next="ii.iii.xxxv" id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p1">5. I will come up - As if he had said, ye deserve that I
should do so. Put off thine ornaments, that I may know what to do with
thee - That is, put thyself into the posture of a penitent, that the
dispute may be determined in thy favour, and mercy may rejoice against
judgment.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p2">6. And Israel stript themselves of their ornaments, by
the mount; or, as some read it, at a distance from the mount - Stand
afar off, like the publican, <scripRef passage="Luke xviii. 13" id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Luke|18|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.18.13">Luke
xviii, 13</scripRef>. God bid them lay aside their ornaments, and they did so;
both to shew in general their deep mourning, and in particular to take a
holy revenge upon themselves for giving their ear-rings to make the
golden calf of.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p3">7. And Moses took the tabernacle - The tent wherein he
gave audience, heard causes, and inquired of God, and pitched it
without, afar off from the camp - To signify to them that they were
unworthy of it. Perhaps this tabernacle was a model of the tabernacle
that was afterwards to be erected, a hasty draught from the pattern
shewed him in the mount, designed for direction to the workman, and used
in the mean time as a tabernacle of meeting between God and Moses about
public affairs.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p4">8. And when Moses went out to the tabernacle, the people
looked after him - In token of their respect to him whom before they had
slighted, and their dependence upon his mediation. By this it appeared,
that they were full of concern what would be the issue.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p5">10. And when they saw the cloudy pillar, that symbol of
God's presence, give Moses the meeting, they all worshipped every man at
his tent door - Thereby they signified, Their humble adoration of the
divine majesty. Their thankfulness to God, that he was pleased to shew
them this token for good, for if he had been pleased to kill them he
would not have shewed them such things as these. And their hearty
concurrence with Moses as their advocate, in every thing he should
promise for them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p6">11. And the Lord spake to Moses face to face as a man
speaketh to his friend - Which intimates not only that God revealed
himself to Moses with greater clearness than to any other of the
prophets, but also with greater expressions of particular kindness than
to any other. He spake not as a prince to a subject, but as a man to his
friend, whom he loves, and with whom he takes sweet counsel. And he
turned again into the camp - To tell the people what hopes he had of
bringing this business to a good issue. But because he intended speedily
to return to the tabernacle, he left Joshua there.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p7">12. Moses now returned to the door of the tabernacle, as
an important supplicant for two favours, and prevails for both: herein
he was a type of Christ the great intercessor, whom the Father heareth
always. He is earnest with God for a grant of his presence with Israel
in the rest of their march to Canaan. Thou sayst, bring up this people -
Lord, it is thou thyself that employest me, and wilt thou not own me? I
am in the way of my duty, and shall I not have thy presence with me in
that way? Yet, Thou hast said, I know thee by name, as a particular
friend, and thou hast also found grace in my sight, above any other.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p8">13. Now therefore, if I have found grace in thy sight,
shew me thy way - What favour God had expressed to the people they had
forfeited the benefit of; and therefore Moses lays the stress of his
plea upon what God had said to him. By this therefore he takes hold on
God, Lord, if thou wilt do any thing for me, do this for the people.
Thus our Lord Jesus, in his intercession, presents himself to the
Father, as one in whom he is always well-pleased, and so obtains mercy
for us with whom he is justly displeased, Shew me thy way, that I may
know thee, that I may find grace in thy sight - He insinuates that the
people also, though most unworthy, yet were in some relation to God;
consider that this nation is thy people; a people that thou hast done
great things for, redeemed to thyself, and taken into covenant with
thyself; Lord, they are thy own, do not leave them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p9">15. And he said, If thy presence go not with me, carry us
not up hence - He speaks as one that dreaded the thought of going
forward without God's presence.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p10">16. Wherein shall it be known to the nations that have
their eyes upon us, that I, and thy people, have found grace in thy
sight; so as to be separated from all people upon earth? Is it not that
thou goest with us? Nothing short of that can answer these
characters.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p11">17. I will do this thing also that thou hast spoken - See
the power of prayer! See the riches of God's goodness! See in type the
prevalency of Christ's intercession, which he ever lives to make for all
those that come to God by him! And the ground of that prevalency, is
purely in his own merit, it is because thou hast found grace in my
sight. And now God is perfectly reconciled to them, and his presence in
the pillar of cloud returns to them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p12">18. I beseech thee shew me thy glory - Moses had lately
been in the mount with God, and had had as intimate communion with God,
as ever any man had on this side heaven, and yet he is still desiring a
farther acquaintance. Shew me thy glory - Make me to see it; so the word
is: make it some way or other visible, and enable me to bear the sight
of it. Not that he was so ignorant as to think God's essence could be
seen with bodily eyes, but having hitherto only heard a voice out of a
pillar of cloud or fire, he desired to see some representation of the
divine glory, such as God saw fit to gratify him with.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p13">20. Thou canst not see my face - A full discovery of the
glory of God would quite overpower the faculties of any mortal man. I
will make all my goodness pass before thee - He had given him wonderful
instances of his goodness in being reconciled to Israel; but that was
only goodness in the stream, he would shew him goodness in the spring.
This was a sufficient answer to his request: Shew me thy glory, saith
Moses; I will shew thee my goodness, saith God. God's goodness is his
glory; and he will have us to know him by the glory of his mercy, more
than by the glory of his majesty. And I will be gracious to whom I will
be gracious - In bestowing his gifts, and is not debtor to any, nor
accountable to any; all his reasons of mercy are fetched from within
himself, not from any merit in his creatures, and I will shew mercy on
whom I will shew mercy - For his grace is always free. He never damns by
prerogative, but by prerogative he saves.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p14">22. I will put thee in a cleft of the rock - In that he
was to be sheltered from the dazzling light, and devouring fire of God's
glory. This was the rock in Horeb, out of which water was brought, of
which it is said, That rock was Christ, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. x. 4" id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p14.1" parsed="|1Cor|10|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10.4">1 Cor. x, 4</scripRef>. 'Tis in the clefts of this rock that we are secured from
the wrath of God, which otherwise would consume us: God himself will
protect those that are thus hid: and it is only through Christ that we
have the knowledge of the glory of God. None can see that to their
comfort, but those that stand upon this rock, and take shelter in
it.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii-p15">23. And I will take away my hand - Speaking after the
manner of men. And thou shalt see my back-parts - The face in man is the
seat of majesty, and men are known by their faces, in them we take a
full view of men; that sight of God Moses might not have, but such a
sight as we have of a man who is gone past us, so that we only see his
back. Now Moses was allowed to see this only, but when he was a witness
to Christ's transfiguration, he saw his face shine as the sun.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIV" progress="42.19%" prev="ii.iii.xxxiv.ii" next="ii.iii.xxxv.i" id="ii.iii.xxxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXXIV" id="ii.iii.xxxv-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|34|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.34" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxxv-p0.2">XXXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXIV" progress="42.19%" prev="ii.iii.xxxv" next="ii.iii.xxxv.ii" id="ii.iii.xxxv.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.i-p1">Four instances of the return of God's favour we have in
this chapter.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxv.i-p2">I. The orders he gives to Moses to come up
to the mount the next morning, and bring two tables of stone with him,
ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxv.i-p3">II. His meeting him there, and the
proclamation of his name, ver. 6-9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxv.i-p4">III. The instructions he gave him there,
and his converse with him forty days, ver. 10-28.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxv.i-p5">IV. The honour he put upon him when he sent
him down with his face shining, ver. 29-35. In all which God dealt with
Moses as a mediator between him and Israel, and a type of the great
Mediator.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXIV" progress="42.20%" prev="ii.iii.xxxv.i" next="ii.iii.xxxvi" id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p1">1. Moses must prepare for the renewing of the tables.
Before God himself provided the tables, and wrote on them; now Moses
must hew him out the tables, and God would only write upon them. When
God was reconciled to them, he ordered the tables to be renewed, and
wrote his law in them, which plainly intimates to us, that even under
the gospel (of which the intercession of Moses was typical) the moral
law should continue to oblige believers. Though Christ has redeemed us
from the curse of the law, yet not from the command of it, but still we
are under the law to Christ. When our saviour in his sermon on the mount
expounded the moral law, and vindicated it from the corrupt glosses with
which the scribes and Pharisees had broken it, he did in effect renew
the tables, and make them like the first; that is, reduce the law to its
primitive sense and intention.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p2">5. The Lord descended - By some sensible token of his
presence, and manifestation of his glory. He descended in the cloud -
Probably that pillar of cloud which had hitherto gone before Israel, and
had the day before met Moses at the door of the tabernacle.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p3">6. And the Lord passed by before him - Fixed views of God
are reserved for the future state; the best we have in this world are
transient. And proclaimed the name of the Lord - By which he would make
himself known. He had made himself known to Moses in the glory of his
self-existence, and self-sufficiency, when he proclaimed that name, I am
that I am; now he makes himself known in the glory of his grace and
goodness, and all- sufficiency to us. The proclaiming of it notes the
universal extent of God's mercy; he is not only good to Israel, but good
to all. The God with whom we have to do is a great God. He is Jehovah,
the Lord, that hath his being of himself, and is the fountain of all
being; Jehovah-El, the Lord, the strong God, a God of almighty power
himself, and the original of all power. This is prefixed before the
display of his mercy, to teach us to think and to speak even of God's
goodness with a holy awe, and to encourage us to depend upon these
mercies. He is a good God. His greatness and goodness illustrate each
other. That his greatness may not make us afraid, we are told how good
he is; and that we may not presume upon his goodness, we are told how
great he is. Many words are here heaped up to acquaint us with, and
convince us of God's goodness.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p4">1st, He is merciful, This speaks his pity, and tender
companion, like that of a father to his children. This is put first,
because it is the first wheel in all the instances of God's goodwill to
fallen man. 2ndly, He is gracious. This speaks both freeness, and
kindness: it speaks him not only to have a compassion to his creatures,
but a complacency in them, and in doing good to them; and this of his
own goodwill, not for the sake of any thing in them. 3rdly, He is
long-suffering. This is a branch of God's goodness which our wickedness
gives occasion for. He is long-suffering, that is, he is slow to anger,
and delays the executions of his justice, he waits to be gracious, and
lengthens out the offers of his mercy. 4thly, He is abundant in goodness
and truth. This speaks plentiful goodness; it abounds above our deserts,
above our conception. The springs of mercy are always full, the streams
of mercy always flowing; there is mercy enough in God, enough for all,
enough for each, enough forever. It speaks promised goodness, goodness
and truth put together, goodness engaged by promise.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p5">5thly, He keepeth mercy for thousands. This speaks,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p6">1. Mercy extended to thousands of persons.
When he gives to some, still he keeps for others, and is never
exhausted:</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p7">2. Mercy entailed upon thousands of
generations, even to those upon whom the ends of the world are come;
nay, the line of it is drawn parallel with that of eternity itself.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p8">6thly, He forgiveth iniquity, transgression and sin -
Pardoning mercy is instanced in, because in that divine grace is most
magnified, and because that it is that opens the door to all other gifts
of grace. He forgives offenses of all sorts, iniquity, transgression and
sin, multiplies his pardons, and with him is plenteous redemption. He is
a just and holy God. For, 1st, He will by no means clear the guilty. He
will not clear the impenitently guilty, those that go on still in their
trespasses; he will not clear the guilty without satisfaction to his
justice. 2ndly, He visits the iniquity of the fathers upon the children
- Especially for the punishment of idolaters. Yet he keepeth not his
anger forever, but visits to the third and fourth generation only,
while he keeps mercy for thousands - This is God's name forever, and
this is his memorial unto all generations.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p9">8. And Moses made haste, and bowed his head - Thus he
expressed his humble reverence and adoration of God's glory, together
with his joy in this discovery God had made of himself, and his
thankfulness for it. Then likewise he expressed his holy submission to
the will of God made known in this declaration, subscribing to his
justice as well as mercy, and putting himself and his people Israel
under the government of such a God as Jehovah had now proclaimed himself
to be. Let this God be our God forever and ever!</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p10">9. And he said, I pray thee go among us - For thy
presence is all to our safety and success. And pardon our iniquity and
our sin - Else we cannot expect thee to go among us. And take us for
thine inheritance - Which thou wilt have a particular eye to, and
concern for. These things God had already promised Moses; and yet he
prays for them, not as doubting the sincerity of God's grants, but as
one solicitous for the ratification of them. But it is a strange plea he
urges, for it is a stiff-necked people - God had given this as a reason
why he would not go along with them, chap. xxxiii, 3. Yea, saith Moses,
the rather go along with us; for the worse they are, the more need they
have of thy presence. Moses sees them so stiff-necked, that he has
neither patience nor power enough to deal with them; therefore, Lord, do
thou go among us; else they will never be kept in awe; thou wilt spare,
and bear with them, for thou art God and not man.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p11">10. Behold I make a covenant - When the covenant was
broke, it was Israel that broke it; now it comes to be renewed, it is
God that makes it. If there be quarrels, we must bear all the blame; if
there be peace, God must have all the glory. Before all thy people I
will do marvels - Such as the drying up of Jordan, the standing still of
the sun. Marvels indeed, for they were without precedent, such as have
not been done in all the earth; the people shall see, and own the work
of the Lord; and they were the terror of their enemies: it is a terrible
thing that I will do.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p12">11. Observe that which I command thee - We cannot expect
the benefit of the promises, unless we make conscience of the precepts.
The two great precepts are,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p13">1. Thou shalt worship no other gods - A
good reason is annexed; for the Lord, whose name is Jealous, is a
jealous God - As tender in the matters of his worship as the husband is
of the honour of the marriage-bed.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p14">2. Thou shalt make thee no molten gods -
Thou shalt not worship the true God by images. This was the sin they had
lately fallen into, which therefore they are particularly cautioned
against. That they might not be tempted to worship other gods, they must
not join in affinity or friendship with those that did.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p15">12. Take heed to thyself - It is a sin thou art prone to,
and that will easily beset thee; carefully abstain from all advances
towards it, make no covenant with the inhabitants of the land - If God
in kindness to them drove out the Canaanites, they ought in duty to God
not to harbour them: If they espoused their children they would be in
danger of espousing their gods. That they might not be tempted to make
molten gods, they must utterly destroy those they found, and all that
belonged to them, the altars and groves, lest, if they were left
standing, they should be brought in process of time either to use them,
or to take pattern by them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p16">21. Here is a repetition of several appointments made
before, especially relating to their solemn feasts: when they had made
the calf they proclaimed a feast in honour of it; now, that they might
never do so again, they are here charged with the observance of the
feasts which God had instituted. Thou shalt rest, even in earing-time
and in harvest - The most busy times of the year. All wordly business
must give way to that holy rest: harvest-work will prosper the better
for the religious observation of the sabbath- day in harvest-time.
Hereby we must shew that we prefer our communion with God, before either
the business or the joy of harvest.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p17">23. Thrice in the year shall all the men-children appear
- But it might be suggested, when all the males slain every part were
gone up to worship in the place that God should chuse, the country would
he left exposed to the insults of their neighbours; and what would
become of the poor women and children? Trust God with them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p18">24. Neither shalt any man desire thy land - Not only they
shall not invade it, but they shall not so much as think of invading it.
What a standing Miracle was this, for so many Generations?</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p19">28. He wrote - God.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p20">29. The skin of his face shone - This time of his being
in the mount he heard only the same he had heard before. But he saw more
of the glory of God, which having with open face beheld, he was in some
measure changed into the same image. This was a great honour done to
Moses, that the people might never again question his mission, or think
or speak slightly of him. He carried his credentials in his very
countenance, some think as long as he lived, he retained some remainders
of this glory, which perhaps contributed to the vigour of his old age;
that eye could not wax dim which had seen God, nor that face wrinkle
which had shone with his glory.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p21">30. And Aaron and the children of Israel saw it, and were
afraid - It not only dazzled their eyes, but struck such an awe upon
them as obliged them to retire. Probably they doubted whether it was a
token of God's favour, or of his displeasure.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p22">33. And Moses put a veil upon his face - This veil
signified the darkness of that dispensation; the ceremonial institutions
had in them much of Christ and the gospel, but a veil was drawn over it,
so that the children of Israel could not distinctly and steadfastly see
those good things to come which the law had a shadow of. It was beauty
veiled, gold in the mine, a pearl in the shell; but thanks be to God, by
the gospel, the veil is taken away from off the old testament; yet still
it remains upon the hearts of those who shut their eyes against the
light.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p23">34. When he went before the Lord, he put off the veil -
Every veil must be thrown aside when we go to present ourselves unto the
Lord. This signified also, as it is explained, <scripRef passage="2 Cor. iii. 16" id="ii.iii.xxxv.ii-p23.1" parsed="|2Cor|3|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.3.16">2 Cor. iii, 16</scripRef>, that when a soul turns to the Lord, the veil shall be taken
away, that with open face it may behold his glory.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXV" progress="42.40%" prev="ii.iii.xxxv.ii" next="ii.iii.xxxvi.i" id="ii.iii.xxxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXXV" id="ii.iii.xxxvi-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|35|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.35" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxxvi-p0.2">XXXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXV" progress="42.40%" prev="ii.iii.xxxvi" next="ii.iii.xxxvi.ii" id="ii.iii.xxxvi.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvi.i-p1">The great affair of setting up God's worship is now upon
its former channel again.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxvi.i-p2">I. Moses gives Israel those instructions he
had received, which required a present observance, (1.) Concerning the
sabbath, ver. 1-3. (2.) Concerning the contribution that was to be made
for erecting the tabernacle, ver. 4-9. (3.) Concerning the framing of
the tabernacle, and the utensils of it, ver. 10-19.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxvi.i-p3">II. The people bring in their
contributions, ver. 20-29.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxvi.i-p4">III. The head workmen are nominated, ver.
30-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXV" progress="42.41%" prev="ii.iii.xxxvi.i" next="ii.iii.xxxvii" id="ii.iii.xxxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvi.ii-p1">2. Six days shall work be done - Work for the tabernacle,
but on the seventh day - You must not strike a stroke, no not at the
tabernacle-work; the honour of the sabbath was above that of the
sanctuary.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvi.ii-p2">3. Ye shall kindle no fire - For any servile work, as
that of smiths or plumbers. We do not find that ever this prohibition
extended farther.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvi.ii-p3">21. Everyone whom his spirit made willing - What they
did they did cheerfully. They were willing; and it was not any external
inducement that made them so, but their spirits. It was from a principle
of love to God, and his service; a desire of his presence with them by
his ordinances; gratitude for the great things he had done for them; and
faith in his promises of what he would do further.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvi.ii-p4">22. Tablets or Lockets.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvi.ii-p5">30. The Lord hath called Bezaleel - And those whom God
called by name to this service, he filled with the spirit of God, to
qualify them for it. The work was extraordinary which Bezaleel was
designed for, and therefore he was qualified in an extraordinary manner
for it. Thus when the apostles were appointed to be master-builders in
setting up the gospel-tabernacle, they were filled with the spirit of
God in wisdom and understanding.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXVI" progress="42.43%" prev="ii.iii.xxxvi.ii" next="ii.iii.xxxvii.i" id="ii.iii.xxxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXXVI" id="ii.iii.xxxvii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|36|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.36" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxxvii-p0.2">XXXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXVI" progress="42.43%" prev="ii.iii.xxxvii" next="ii.iii.xxxvii.ii" id="ii.iii.xxxvii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvii.i-p1">In this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxvii.i-p2">I. The work of the tabernacle is begun,
ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxvii.i-p3">II. A stop put to the people's
contributions, ver. 5-7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxvii.i-p4">III. A particular account of the making the
tabernacle; the fine curtains of it, ver. 8-13. The coarse ones, ver.
14-19. The boards, ver. 20-xxx, The bars, ver. 31-34 The partition veil,
ver. 35, 36. and the hangings of the door, ver. 37, 38.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXVI" progress="42.43%" prev="ii.iii.xxxvii.i" next="ii.iii.xxxviii" id="ii.iii.xxxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvii.ii-p1">2. And Moses called Bezaleel - "Even those whom God has
qualified for, and inclined to the service of the tabernacle, yet must
wait for a call to it, either extraordinary, as that of preachers and
apostles, or ordinary, as that of pastors and teachers. And observe who
they were that Moses called; those in whose heart God had put wisdom for
this purpose, beyond their natural capacity, and whose heart stirred him
up to come to the work in good earnest." Those are to be called to the
building of the gospel tabernacle, whom God has by his grace made in
some measure fit for the work, and free to it: ability and willingness,
with resolution, are the two things to be regarded in the call of
ministers.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvii.ii-p2">35. The veil made for a partition between the holy place
and the most holy, signified the darkness and distance of that
dispensation compared with the New Testament, which shews us the glory
of God more clearly, and invites us to draw near to it; and the darkness
and distance of our present state in comparison with heaven, where we
shall be ever with the Lord, and see him as he is.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxvii.ii-p3">37. An hanging - Which divided the holy place from the
court.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXVII" progress="42.45%" prev="ii.iii.xxxvii.ii" next="ii.iii.xxxviii.i" id="ii.iii.xxxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXXVII" id="ii.iii.xxxviii-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|37|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.37" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxxviii-p0.2">XXXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXVII" progress="42.45%" prev="ii.iii.xxxviii" next="ii.iii.xxxviii.ii" id="ii.iii.xxxviii.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxviii.i-p1">Bezaleel and his workmen are still busy, making,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxviii.i-p2">I. The ark with the mercy-seat and the
cherubim, ver. 1-9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxviii.i-p3">II. The table with its vessels, ver.
10-16.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxviii.i-p4">III. The candle-stick with its
appurtenances, ver. 17-24.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxviii.i-p5">IV. The golden altar for incense, ver.
25-28.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxviii.i-p6">V. The holy oil and incense, ver. 29. 1-9.
These several ornaments where with the tabernacle was furnished, the
people were not admitted to see, but the priests only; and therefore it
was requisite they should be thus largely described, particularly to
them. And Moses would thus shew the great care which he and his workmen
took to make every thing exactly according to the pattern shewed him in
the mount. Thus he appeals to every reader concerning his fidelity to
him that appointed him, in all his house. And thus he teacheth us to
have respect to all God's commandments, even to every jot and tittle of
them. In these verses we have an account of the making of the ark with
its glorious and significant appurtenances, the mercy-seat and the
cherubim. Consider these three together, and they represent the glory of
a holy God, the sincerity of a holy heart, and the communion that is
between them by a Mediator. It is the glory of a holy God that he
dwelleth between the cherubim, that is, is continually attended by the
blessed angels, whose swiftness was signified by the wings of the
cherubim, and their unanimity in their services, by their faces being
one towards another. It is the character of an upright heart, that, like
the ark of the testimony, it hath the law of God hid and kept in it. By
Jesus Christ the great propitiation there is reconciliation made, and a
communion settled, between us and God: he interposeth between us and
God's displeasure; and through him we become entitled to God's
favour.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXVII" progress="42.49%" prev="ii.iii.xxxviii.i" next="ii.iii.xxxix" id="ii.iii.xxxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxviii.ii-p1">10. Observe how much the dispensation of the gospel
exceeds that of the law. Tho' here was a table furnished, it was only
with shew- bread, bread to be looked upon, not to be fed upon, while it
was on the table, and afterwards only by the priests: but to the table
Christ has spread in the new covenant all good Christians are invited
guests, and to them it is said, Eat, O friends, come eat of my bread.
What the law gave but a sight of at a distance, the gospel gives the
enjoyment of.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxviii.ii-p2">17. This candlestick, which was not of wood overlaid with
gold, but all beaten-work of pure gold only, signified that light of
divine Revelation with which God's church upon earth (which is his
tabernacle among men) hath always been enlightened, being always
supplied with fresh oil from Christ the good olive, <scripRef passage="Zech. iv. 2, 3" id="ii.iii.xxxviii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Zech|4|2|4|3" osisRef="Bible:Zech.4.2-Zech.4.3">Zech. iv, 2, 3</scripRef>. The bible is a golden candlestick, it is of pure gold; from
it light is diffused to every part of God's tabernacle, that by it the
spiritual priests may see to do the service of his sanctuary. The
candlestick has not only its bowls for necessary use, but its knops and
flowers for ornament; many things which God saw fit to beautify his word
with, which we can no more give a reason for than for these knops and
flowers, and yet must be sure they wert added for good purpose. Let us
bless God for this candlestick, have an eye to it continually, and dread
the removal of it out of its place!</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxviii.ii-p3">25. The incense burnt on this altar daily, signified both
the prayers of saints, and the intercession of Christ, to which is owing
the acceptableness of them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXVIII" progress="42.51%" prev="ii.iii.xxxviii.ii" next="ii.iii.xxxix.i" id="ii.iii.xxxix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXXVIII" id="ii.iii.xxxix-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|38|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.38" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xxxix-p0.2">XXXVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXVIII" progress="42.51%" prev="ii.iii.xxxix" next="ii.iii.xxxix.ii" id="ii.iii.xxxix.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxix.i-p1">Here is an account,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxix.i-p2">I. Of the making of the brazen altar, ver.
1-7. and the laver, ver. 8.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxix.i-p3">II. The preparing of the hangings for the
inclosing of the court in which the tabernacle was to stand, ver.
9-20.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xxxix.i-p4">III. A summary account of the gold, silver
and brass that was contributed to, and, used in the preparing of the
tabernacle, ver. 21-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXVIII" progress="42.52%" prev="ii.iii.xxxix.i" next="ii.iii.xl" id="ii.iii.xxxix.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xxxix.ii-p1">1. The altar of burnt-offering - On this all their
sacrifices were offered. Christ was himself the altar to his own
sacrifice of atonement, and so he is to all our sacrifices of
acknowledgment. We must have an eye to him in offering them, as God hath
in accepting them.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxix.ii-p2">8. This laver signified the provision that is made in the
gospel for cleansing our souls from the pollution of sin by the merit of
Christ, that we may be fit to serve the holy God in holy duties. This is
here said to be made of the looking-glasses of the women that assembled
at the door of the tabernacle. It should seem these women were eminent
for devotion, attending more constantly at the place of public worship
than others, and notice is here taken of it to their honour. These
looking-glasses were of the finest brass, burnished for that purpose. In
the laver, either they were artfully joined together, or else molten
down and cast anew; but it is probable the laver was so brightly
burnished that the sides of it still served for looking-glasses, that
the priests when they came to wash might there see their faces, and so
discover the spots to wash them clean.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxix.ii-p3">9. And he made the court - The walls of the court, were
like the rest, curtains, or hangings. This represented the state of the
Old Testament church, it was a garden enclosed; the worshippers were
then confined to a little compass. But the inclosure being of curtains
only, intimated that that confinement of the church to one particular
nation was not to be perpetual. The dispensation itself was a
tabernacle-dispensation, moveable and mutable, and in due time to be
taken down and folded up, when the place of the tent should be enlarged,
and its cords lengthened, to make room for the Gentile world.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xxxix.ii-p4">21. By the hand of Ithamar - Here we have a breviate of
the account which by Moses's appointment the Levites took and kept of
the gold, silver, and brass, that was brought in for the tabernacle's
use, and how it was employed. Ithamar the son of Aaron was appointed to
draw up this account. All the gold amounted to twenty nine talents, and
seven hundred and thirty shekels over; Which some compute to be about
one hundred and fifty thousand pounds worth of gold, according to the
present value of it. The silver amounted to about thirty-four thousand
pounds of our money. The raising of the gold by voluntary contribution,
and of the silver by way of tribute, shews that either way may be taken
for the defraying of public expences, provided that nothing be done with
partiality.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIX" progress="42.56%" prev="ii.iii.xxxix.ii" next="ii.iii.xl.i" id="ii.iii.xl">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XXXIX" id="ii.iii.xl-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|39|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.39" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xl-p0.2">XXXIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXIX" progress="42.56%" prev="ii.iii.xl" next="ii.iii.xl.ii" id="ii.iii.xl.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xl.i-p1">This chapter gives us an account of the finishing of the
work of the tabernacle.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xl.i-p2">I. The last thing prepared was the holy
garments. The ephod, and its curious girdle, ver. 1-5. The onyx stones
for the shoulders, ver. 6, 7. The breast-plate with the precious stones
in it, ver. 8-21. The robe of the ephod, ver. 22-26. The coats, bonnets
and breeches for the inferior priests, ver. 27-29. And the plate of the
holy crown, ver. 30, 31.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xl.i-p3">II. A summary account of the whole work,
ver. 32-43.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXIX" progress="42.57%" prev="ii.iii.xl.i" next="ii.iii.xli" id="ii.iii.xl.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xl.ii-p1">1. The priests garments are called here clothes of
service - Those that wear robes of honour must look upon them as clothes
of service; for those upon whom honour is put, from them service is
expected. Holy garments were not made for men to sleep in, but to do
service in, and then they are indeed for glory and beauty. These also
were shadows of good things to come, but the substance is Christ. He is
our great high priest; he put upon him the clothes of service when he
undertook the work of our redemption; arrayed himself with the gifts and
graces of the Spirit, which he received not by measure; charged himself
with all God's spiritual Israel, bare them on his shoulder, carried them
in his bosom, and presented them in the breast-plate of judgment unto
his Father. And, lastly, he crowned himself with holiness to the Lord,
consecrated his whole undertaking to the honour of his Fathers holiness.
And all true believers are spiritual priests. The clean linen with which
all their clothes of service must be made, is the righteousness of
saints: and holiness to the Lord must be so written upon their
foreheads, that all who converse with them may see they bear the image
of God's holiness.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xl.ii-p2">32. Thus was all the work finished - In not much more
than five months. Though there was a great deal of fine work, such as
used to be the work of time, embroidering, and engraving, not only in
gold, but in precious stones, yet they went through with it in a little
time, and with the greatest exactness imaginable. The workmen were
taught of God, and so were kept from making blunders, which would have
retarded them. And the people were hearty and zealous in the work, and
impatient till it was finished. God had prepared their hearts, and then
the thing was done suddenly, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxix. 36" id="ii.iii.xl.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Chr|29|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.29.36">2
Chron. xxix, 36</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xl.ii-p3">43. And Moses did look upon all the work - Piece by
Piece, and behold they had done it according to the pattern shewed him -
For the same that shewed him the pattern, guided their hand in the work.
And Moses blessed them - He not only praised them, but prayed for them:
he blessed them as one having authority. We read not of any wages Moses
paid them for their work, but his blessing he gave them. For though
ordinarily the labourer be worthy of his hire, yet in this case, they
wrought for themselves. The honour and comfort of God's tabernacle among
them would be recompence enough. And they had their meat from heaven on
free-cost, for themselves and their families, and their raiment waxed
not old upon them; so that they neither needed wages, nor had reason to
expect any. But indeed this blessing in the name of the Lord was wages
enough for all their work. Those whom God employs he will bless, and
those whom he blesseth, they are blessed indeed. The blessing he
commands is life forevermore.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XL" progress="42.62%" prev="ii.iii.xl.ii" next="ii.iii.xli.i" id="ii.iii.xli">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Exod. XL" id="ii.iii.xli-p0.1" parsed="|Exod|40|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.40" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iii.xli-p0.2">XL</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XL" progress="42.62%" prev="ii.iii.xli" next="ii.iii.xli.ii" id="ii.iii.xli.i">

<p id="ii.iii.xli.i-p1">In this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xli.i-p2">I. Orders are given for setting up the
tabernacle, and fixing all the appurtenances of it, ver. 1-8. and the
consecrating of it, ver. 8-11. and of the priests, ver. 12-15.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xli.i-p3">II. Care taken to do all this, and as it
was appointed to be done, ver. 16-33.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iii.xli.i-p4">III. God's taking possession of it by the
cloud, ver. 34-38.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XL" progress="42.63%" prev="ii.iii.xli.i" next="ii.iv" id="ii.iii.xli.ii">

<p id="ii.iii.xli.ii-p1">2. The time for doing this is, On the first day of the
first month - This wanted but fourteen days of a year since they came
out of Egypt. Probably the work was made ready just at the end of the
year, so that the appointing this day gave no delay. In Hezekiah's time
they began to sanctify the temple on the first day of the first month, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxix. 17" id="ii.iii.xli.ii-p1.1" parsed="|2Chr|29|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.29.17">2 Chron. xxix, 17</scripRef>. The new moon (which by their computation was the first day
of every month) was observed by them with some solemnity; and therefore
this first new moon of the year was thus made remarkable.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xli.ii-p2">15. Their anointing shall be an everlasting priesthood -
A seal that their priesthood shall continue as long as the Jewish polity
lasts. He signifies that this unction should be sufficient for all
succeeding priests. None were afterwards anointed but the high-
priests.</p>

<p id="ii.iii.xli.ii-p3">34. As when God had finished this earth, which he
designed for man's habitation, he made man, and put him in possession of
it; so when Moses had finished the tabernacle, which was designed for
God's dwelling-place among men, God came and took possession of it. By
these visible tokens of his coming among them, he testified both the
return of his favour, which they had forfeited by the golden calf, and
his gracious acceptance of their care and pains about the tabernacle.
Thus God shewed himself well- pleased with what they had done, and
abundantly rewarded them. A cloud covered the tent - The same cloud
which, as the chariot or pavilion of the Shechinah, had come up before
them out of Egypt, now settled upon the tabernacle, and hovered over it,
even in the hottest and clearest day; for it was none of those clouds
which the sun scatters. This cloud was intended to be a token of God's
presence, constantly visible day and night to all Israel. A protection
of the tabernacle: they had sheltered it with one covering upon another,
but after all, the cloud that covered it was its best guard: And a guide
to the camp of Israel in their march through the wilderness. While the
cloud continued on the tabernacle, they rested; when it removed, they
removed and followed it, as being purely under a divine conduct. And the
glory of the Lord filled the tabernacle - The Shechinah now made an
awful entry into the tabernacle, passing through the outer part of it
into the most holy place, and there seating itself between the cherubim.
It was in light and fire, and, for ought we know, no other-wise, that
the Shechinah made itself visible. With these the tabernacle was now
filled; yet as before the bush, so now the curtains were not consumed,
for, to those that have received the anointing, the majesty of God is
not destroying. Yet now so dazzling was the light, and so dreadful was
the fire, that Moses was not able to enter into the tent of the
congregation, at the door of which he attended, till the splendour was a
little abated, and the glory of the Lord retired within the veil. But
what Moses could not do, our Lord Jesus has done, whom God caused to
draw near and approach, and as the fore-runner he is for us entered, and
has invited us to come boldly even to the mercy-seat. He was able to
enter into the holy place not made with hands; he is himself the true
tabernacle, filled with the glory of God, even with that divine grace
and truth which were figured by this fire and light. In him the
Shechinah took up its rest forever, for in him dwells all the fulness
of the Godhead bodily.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE THIRD BOOK OF MOSES CALLED LEVITICUS" progress="42.69%" prev="ii.iii.xli.ii" next="ii.iv.i" id="ii.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev" id="ii.iv-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.iv-p0.2">NOTES ON THE THIRD BOOK OF MOSES CALLED LEVITICUS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Leviticus and Chapter I" progress="42.69%" prev="ii.iv" next="ii.iv.ii" id="ii.iv.i">

<p id="ii.iv.i-p1">THIS book, containing the actions of about one month's
space, acquaint us with the Levitical ceremonies used after the
tabernacle was erected in the wilderness, and is therefore called
Leviticus: It treats of laws concerning persons, and things, clean and
unclean; as also purifyings in general once a year, and divers
particular cleansings, with a brief repetition of divers laws, together
with certain feasts, of seven years rest, of the jubilee, and the
redemption of things consecrated to God; but especially of such
ceremonies as were used about offerings and sacrifices, which were both
expiatory for trespasses committed, whether by the People or the
priests; and also eucharistical in the owning of God's blessings. Here
are declared also laws for the regulating of these, and prescribing the
lawful time for marriages; here is set down how several abominable sins
are punishable by the magistrate; and how these things are to be managed
by certain persons appropriated to the tribe of Levi, whose office is
confirmed from heaven, and the male-administration of it threatened, and
the judgment particularly inflicted on Nadab and Abihu for an example.
Here are promises, and threatenings, to the observers, or breakers of
this law. The records of even these abrogated laws are of use to us, for
the strengthening of our faith in it, as the lamb slain from the
foundation of the world; and for the increase of our thankfulness to
God, for freeing us from that heavy yoke. Directions concerning
burnt-offerings: A bullock, ver. 1-9. A sheep, goat, lamb, or kid, ver.
10-13. A turtle dove, or young pigeon, ver. 14-17.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="42.72%" prev="ii.iv.i" next="ii.iv.ii.i" id="ii.iv.ii">

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="42.72%" prev="ii.iv.ii" next="ii.iv.iii" id="ii.iv.ii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p1">1. Moses - Stood without, <scripRef passage="Exod. xl. 35" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|40|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.40.35">Exod. xl, 35</scripRef>, waiting for God's call. The tabernacle - From the
mercy-seat in the tabernacle.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p2">2. There are divers kinds of sacrifices here prescribed,
some by way of acknowledgment to God for mercies either desired or
received; others by was of satisfaction to God for men's sins; others
were mere exercises of devotion. And the reason why there were so many
kinds of them was, partly a respect to the childish state of the Jews,
who by the custom of nations, and their own natural inclinations were
much addicted to outward rites and ceremonies, that they might have full
employment of that kind in Gods's service, and thereby be kept from
temptations to idolatry; and partly to represent as well the several
perfections of Christ, the true sacrifice, and the various benefits of
his death, as the several duties which men owe to their Creator and
Redeemer, all which could not be so well expressed by one sort of
sacrifice. Of the flock - Or, Of the sheep; though the Hebrew word
contains both the sheep and goats. Now God chose these creatures for his
sacrifices, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p3">1. In opposition to the Egyptian idolatry,
to which divers of the Israelites had been used, and were still in
danger of revolting to again, that the frequent destruction of these
creatures might bring such silly deities into contempt. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p4">2. Because these are the fittest
representations both of Christ and of true Christians, as being gentle,
and harmless, and patient, and useful to men. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p5">3. As the best and most profitable
creatures, with which it is fit God should be served, and which we
should be ready to part with, when God requires us to do so. Or.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p6">4. As things most common, that men might
never want a sacrifice when they needed, or God required it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p7">3. A burnt sacrifice - Strictly so called, such as was to
be all burnt, the skin excepted. For every sacrifice was burnt, more or
less. The sacrifices signified that the whole man, in whose stead the
sacrifice was offered, was to be entirely offered or devoted to God's
service; and that the whole man did deserve to be utterly consumed, if
God should deal severely with him; and directed us to serve the Lord
with all singleness of heart, and to be ready to offer to God even such
sacrifices or services wherein we ourselves should have no part or
benefit. A male - As being more perfect than the female, <scripRef passage="Mal. i. 14" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p7.1" parsed="|Mal|1|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mal.1.14">Mal. i, 14</scripRef>, and more truly representing Christ. Without blemish - To
signify,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p8">1. That God should be served with the best
of every kind.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p9">2. That man, represented by these
sacrifices, should aim at all perfection of heart and life, and that
Christians should one day attain to it, <scripRef passage="Eph. v. 27" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p9.1" parsed="|Eph|5|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.5.27">Eph. v, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p10">3. The spotless and compleat holiness of
Christ. Of his own will - According to this translation, the place
speaks only of free-will offerings, or such as were not prescribed by
God to be offered in course, but were offered by the voluntary devotion
of any person, either by way of supplication for any mercy, or by way of
thanksgiving for any blessing received. But it may seem improper to
restrain the rules here given to free-will offerings, which were to be
observed in other offerings also. At the door - In the court near the
door, where the altar stood, ver. 5. For here it was to be sacrificed,
and here the people might behold the oblation of it. And this farther
signified, that men could have no entrance, neither into the earthly
tabernacle, the church, nor into the heavenly tabernacle of glory, but
by Christ, who is the door, <scripRef passage="John x. 7, 9" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p10.1" parsed="|John|10|7|0|0;|John|10|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.10.7 Bible:John.10.9">John x, 7, 9</scripRef>, by whom alone we have access to God.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p11">4. He shall put his hand - Both his hands, chap. viii,
14, 18, and chap. xvi, 21. Whereby he signified,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p12">1. that he willingly gave it to the
Lord.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p13">2. That he judged himself worthy of that
death which it suffered in his stead; and that he laid his sins upon it
with an eye to him upon whom God would lay the iniquity of us all, <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 6" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p13.1" parsed="|Isa|53|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.6">Isaiah liii, 6</scripRef>, and that together with it he did freely offer up himself to
God. To make atonement - Sacramentally; as directing his faith and
thoughts to that true propitiatory sacrifice which in time was to be
offered up for him. And although burnt-offerings were commonly offered
by way of thanksgiving; yet they were sometimes offered by way of
atonement for sin, that is, for sins in general, as appears from <scripRef passage="Job i. 5" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p13.2" parsed="|Job|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.1.5">Job i, 5</scripRef>, but for particular sins there were special sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p14">5. And he - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p15">1. the offerer, who is said to do it,
namely, by the priest; for men are commonly said to do what they cause
others to do, as <scripRef passage="John iv. 1, 2" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p15.1" parsed="|John|4|1|4|2" osisRef="Bible:John.4.1-John.4.2">John iv, 1, 2</scripRef>. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p16">2. the priest, as it follows, or the
Levite, whose office this was. Shall sprinkle the blood - Which was done
in a considerable quantity, and whereby was signified,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p17">1. That the offerer deserved to have his
blood spilt in that manner.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p18">2. That the blood of Christ should be
poured forth for sinners, and that this was the only mean of their
reconciliation to God, and acceptance with him.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p19">6. Pieces - Namely, the head, and fat, and inwards, and
legs, ver. 8, 9.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p20">7. Put fire - Or, dispose the fire, that is, blow it up,
and put it together, so as it might be fit for the present work. For the
fire there used and allowed came down from heaven, chap. ix, 24, and was
to be carefully preserved there, and all other fire was forbidden, chap.
x, 1, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p21">8. The fat - All the fat was to be separated from the
flesh, and to be put together, to increase the flame, and to consume the
other parts of the sacrifice more speedily.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p22">9. But the inwards shall he wash - To signify the
universal and perfect purity both of the inwards, or the heart, and of
the legs, or ways or actions, which was in Christ, and which should be
in all Christians. And he washed not only the parts now mentioned, but
all the rest, the trunk of the body, and the shoulders. A sweet savour -
Not in itself, for so it rather caused a stink, but as it represented
Christ's offering up himself to God as a sweet smelling savour.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p23">11. North-ward - Here this and other kinds of sacrifices
were killed, chap. vi, 25, and chap. vii, 2, because here seems to have
been the largest and most convenient place for that work, the altar
being probably near the middle of the east-end of the building, and the
entrance being on the south-side. Besides this might design the place of
Christ's death both more generally, in Jerusalem, which was in the sides
of the north, <scripRef passage="Psalm xlviii. 2" id="ii.iv.ii.i-p23.1" parsed="|Ps|48|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.48.2">Psalm xlviii,
2</scripRef>, and more specially, on mount Calvary, which was on the
northwest side of Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p24">14. Turtle-doves - These birds were appointed for the
poor who could not bring better. And these birds are preferred before
others, partly because they were easily gotten, and partly because they
are fit representations of Christ's chastity, and meekness, and
gentleness, for which these birds are remarkable. The pigeons must be
young, because then they are best; but the turtle-doves are better when
they are grown up, and therefore they are not confined to that age.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p25">15. His head - From the rest of the body; as sufficiently
appears, because this was to be burnt by itself, and the body
afterwards, ver. 17. And whereas it is said chap. v, 8. He shall - wring
his head from his neck, but shall not divide it asunder, that is spoken
not of the burnt-offering as here, but of the sin-offering.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p26">16. With its feathers - Or, with its dung or filth,
contained in the crop and in the guts. On the east - Of the Tabernacle.
Here the filth was cast, because this was the remotest place from the
holy of holies, which was in the west-end; to teach us, that impure
things and persons should not presume to approach to God, and that they
should be banished from his presence. The place of the ashes - Where the
ashes fell down and lay, whence they were afterwards removed without the
camp.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ii.i-p27">17. He shall cleave the bird through the whole length,
yet so as not to separate the one side from the other. A sweet savour
unto the Lord - Yet after all, to love God with all our hearts, and to
love our neighbour as ourselves, is better than all burnt-offerings and
sacrifices.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="42.86%" prev="ii.iv.ii.i" next="ii.iv.iii.i" id="ii.iv.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. II" id="ii.iv.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="42.86%" prev="ii.iv.iii" next="ii.iv.iii.ii" id="ii.iv.iii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.iii.i-p1">Directions concerning the meal-offerings.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.iii.i-p2">I. Of fine flour with oil and frankincense,
ver. 1-11.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.iii.i-p3">II. Of the first fruits, ver. 12-16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="42.86%" prev="ii.iv.iii.i" next="ii.iv.iv" id="ii.iv.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p1">1. A meal-offering - (Not meat-offering, an ancient false
print, which has run thro' many editions of our bible.) This was of two
kinds, the one joined with other offerings, <scripRef passage="Num. xv. 4, 7, 10" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Num|15|4|0|0;|Num|15|7|0|0;|Num|15|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.15.4 Bible:Num.15.7 Bible:Num.15.10">Num. xv, 4, 7, 10</scripRef>, which was prescribed, together with the measure or
proportion of it: the other, of which this place speaks, was left to the
offerer's good will both for the thing, and for the quantity. And the
matter for this offering was things without life, as meal, corn, or
cakes. Now this sort of sacrifices were appointed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p2">1. because these are things of greatest
necessity and benefit to man, and therefore it is meet that God should
be served with them, and owned and praised as the giver of them.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p3">2. In condescension to the poor, that they
might not want an offering for God, and to shew that God would accept
even the meanest services, when offered with a sincere mind.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p4">3. These were necessary provisions for the
feast which was to be presented to God, and for the use of the priests,
who were to attend upon these holy ministrations. He shall pour oil -
This may note the graces of the Holy Ghost, which are compared to oil,
and anointing with it, <scripRef passage="Psalm xlv. 7, 1" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Ps|45|7|0|0;|Ps|45|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.45.7 Bible:Ps.45.1">Psalm xlv, 7, 1</scripRef> <scripRef passage="John ii. 20" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p4.2" parsed="|John|2|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.2.20">John ii, 20</scripRef>, and which are necessary to make any offering acceptable to
God. Frankincense - Manifestly designed Christ's satisfaction and
intercession, which is compared to a sweet odour, <scripRef passage="Eph. v. 2" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p4.3" parsed="|Eph|5|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.5.2">Eph. v,
2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p5">2. He shall take - That priest to whom he brought it, and
who is appointed to offer it. The memorial - That part thus selected and
offered; which is called a memorial, either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p6">1. to the offerer, who by offering this
part is minded, that the whole of that he brought, and of all which he
hath of that kind, is God's to whom this part was paid as an
acknowledgment. Or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p7">2. to God, whom (to speak after the manner
of men) this did put in mind of his gracious covenant and promises of
favour, and acceptance of the offerer and his offering. A sweet savour
unto the Lord - And so are our spiritual offerings, which are made by
the fire of holy love, particularly that of almsgiving. With such
sacrifices God is well-pleased.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p8">3. Sons - To be eaten by them, chap. vi, 16. Most holy -
Or such as were to be eaten only by the priests, and that only in the
holy place near the altar.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p9">4. In the oven - Made in the sanctuary for that use.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p10">6. In pieces - Because part of it was offered to God, and
part given to the priests.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p11">11. No leaven - Namely, in that which is offered of
free-will; for in other offerings it might be used, chap. vii, xxiii.
This was forbidden, partly to mind them of their deliverance out of
Egypt, when they were forced thro' haste to bring away their meal or
dough (which was the matter of this oblation) unleavened; partly to
signify what Christ would be, and what they should be, pure and free
from all error in the faith and worship of God, and from all hypocrisy,
and malice or wickedness, all which are signified by leaven. Nor any
honey - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p12">1. because it hath the same effect with
leaven in paste or dough, making it sour, and swelling. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p13">2. in opposition to the sacrifices of the
Gentiles, in which the use of honey was most frequent. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p14">3. to teach us, that God's worship is not
to be governed by men's fancies and appetites but by God's will.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p15">12. Ye may offer them - Or either of them, leaven or
honey. They shall not be burnt - But reserved for the priests.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p16">13. Salt - To signify that incorruption of mind, and
sincerity of grace, which in scripture is signified by salt, <scripRef passage="Mark ix. 49" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Mark|9|49|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mark.9.49">Mark ix, 49</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Colossians iv. 6" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p16.2" parsed="|Col|4|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Col.4.6">Colossians iv, 6</scripRef>, and which is necessary in all them that would offer an
acceptable offering to God. Or in testimony of that communion which they
had with God in these exercises of worship; salt being the great symbol
of friendship in all nations is called, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p17">1. because it represented the perpetuity of
God's covenant with them, which is designed by salt, <scripRef passage="Num. xviii. 19" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Num|18|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.18.19">Num. xviii, 19</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xiii. 5" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p17.2" parsed="|2Chr|13|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.13.5">2 Chron. xiii, 5</scripRef>. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p18">2. because it was so particularly required
as a condition of their covenant with God; this being made absolutely
necessary in all their offerings; and as the neglect of sacrifices was a
breach of covenant on their part, so also was the neglect of salt in
their sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p19">14. First-fruits - Of thine own free-will; for there were
other first-fruits, and that of several sorts, which were prescribed,
and the time, quality, and proportion of them appointed by God.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iii.ii-p20">16. Made by fire - The fire denotes that fervency of
spirit, which ought to be in all our religious services. Holy love is
the fire, by which all our offerings must be made: else they are not of
a sweet savour to God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="42.94%" prev="ii.iv.iii.ii" next="ii.iv.iv.i" id="ii.iv.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. III" id="ii.iv.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="42.94%" prev="ii.iv.iv" next="ii.iv.iv.ii" id="ii.iv.iv.i">

<p id="ii.iv.iv.i-p1">Directions concerning peace-offerings. A bullock or an
heifer, ver. 1-5. A lamb, ver. 6-11. A goat, ver. 12-16. No fat or blood
to be eaten, ver. 17.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="42.95%" prev="ii.iv.iv.i" next="ii.iv.v" id="ii.iv.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p1">1. A peace-offering - This was an offering for peace and
prosperity, and the blessing of God, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p2">1. obtained, and so it was a
thank-offering, or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p3">2. desired; and so it was a kind of
supplication to God. A female - Which were allowed here, tho' not in
burnt-offerings, because those principally respected the honour of God,
who is to be served with the best; but the peace-offerings did primarily
respect the benefit of the offerer, and therefore the choice was left to
himself. Burnt-offerings had regard to God, as in himself the best of
beings, and therefore were wholly burned. But peace-offerings had regard
to God as a benefactor to his creatures, and therefore were divided
between the altar, the priest, and the offerer.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p4">2. At the door - Not on the north-side of the altar,
where the burnt- offering was killed, as also the sin-offering, and the
trespass- offering, but in the very entrance of the court where the
brazen altar stood, which place was not so holy as the other; as appears
both because it was more remote from the holy of holies, and because the
ashes of the sacrifices were to be laid here. And the reason of this
difference is not obscure, both because part of this sacrifice was to be
waved by the hands of the offerer, chap. vii, 30, who might not come
into the court; and because this offering was not so holy as the others,
which were to be eaten only by the priest, whereas part of these were
eaten by the offerer.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p5">5. Upon the burnt sacrifice - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p6">1. Upon the remainders of it, which were
yet burning; or rather,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p7">2. After it; for the daily burnt-offering
was first to be offered, both as more eminently respecting God's honour;
and as the most solemn and stated sacrifice, which should take place of
all occasional oblations, and as a sacrifice of an higher nature, being
for atonement, without which no peace could be obtained, nor peace
offering offered with acceptance.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p8">9. The rump - Which in sheep is fat, and sweet, and in
these parts was very much larger and better than ours.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p9">11. Burnt it - The parts now mentioned; the rest fell to
the priest, chap. vii, 31. The food - That is, the fuel of the fire, or
the matter of the offering. It is called food, Hebrew. bread, to note
God's acceptance of it, and delight in it; as men delight in their
food.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p10">16. Shall burn them - The parts mentioned, among which
the tail is not one, as it was in the sheep. because that in goats is a
refuse part. All the fat - This is to be limited,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p11">1. To those beasts, which were offered or
offerable in sacrifice, as it is explained, chap. vii, 23, 25.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p12">2. To that kind of fat which is
above-mentioned, and required to be offered, which was separated, or
easily separable from the flesh for the fat which was here and there
mixed with the flesh they might eat.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p13">17. All your dwellings - Not only at or near the
tabernacle, not only of those beasts which you actually sacrifice, but
also in your several dwellings, and of all that kind of beasts. Fat -
Was forbidden,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p14">1. To preserve the reverence of the holy
rites and sacrifices.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p15">2. That they might be taught hereby to
acknowledge God as their Lord, and the Lord of all the creatures, who
might reserve what he pleased to himself.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.iv.ii-p16">3. To exercise them in obedience to God,
and self-denial and mortification of their appetites, even in those
things which probably many of them would much desire. Blood - Was
forbidden partly to maintain reverence to God and his worship; partly
out of opposition to idolaters, who used to drink the blood of their
sacrifices; partly with respect to Christ's Blood, thereby manifestly
signified. God would not permit the very shadows of this to be used as a
common thing. Nor will he allow us, tho' we have the comfort of the
atonement made, to assume to ourselves any share in the honour of making
it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="43.01%" prev="ii.iv.iv.ii" next="ii.iv.v.i" id="ii.iv.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. IV" id="ii.iv.v-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="43.01%" prev="ii.iv.v" next="ii.iv.v.ii" id="ii.iv.v.i">

<p id="ii.iv.v.i-p1">Directions concerning sin-offerings; which were intended
for sins committed thro' ignorance, either by the priest himself, ver.
1-12. or by the whole congregation, ver. 13-21. or by a ruler, ver.
22-26. or by a private person, ver. 27-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="43.02%" prev="ii.iv.v.i" next="ii.iv.vi" id="ii.iv.v.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p1">1. The Lord spake unto Moses - The laws contained in the
three first chapters, seem to have been delivered to Moses at one time.
Here begin the laws of another day, which God delivered from between the
Cherubim.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p2">2. If a soul sin - This must necessarily be understood of
more than common daily infirmities; for if every such sin had required
an offering, it had not been possible either for most sinners to bear
such a charge, or for the altar to receive so many sacrifices, or for
the priests to manage so infinite a work. And for ordinary sins, they
were ceremonially expiated by the daily offering, and by that on the
great day of atonement, chap. xvi, 30. Through ignorance - Or, error,
either not knowing his act to be sinful, as appears by comparing ver.
13, 14, or not considering it, but falling into sin thro' the power of
some sudden passion or temptation, as the Hebrew word signifies, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.iv.v.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm
1</scripRef>xix, 67. Things which ought not to be done - The words may be rendered,
in or about every, or any of the commandments of the Lord which should
not be done; or, which concern things that should not be done, namely,
in any negative commands. (And there is great reason why a sacrifice
should be more necessary for these, than for other sins, because
affirmative precepts do not so strictly and constantly bind men as the
negative do.) Then he shall offer according to his quality, which is
here to be understood out of the following verses.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p3">3. If the priest - That is, the high-priest, who only was
anointed after the first time. His anointing is mentioned, because he
was not compleat high-priest 'till he was anointed. Do sin - Either in
doctrine or practice, which it is here supposed he may do. And this is
noted as a character of imperfection in the priesthood of the law,
whereby the Israelites were directed to expect another and better
high-priest, even one who is holy, harmless, and separate from sinners, <scripRef passage="Heb. vii. 26" id="ii.iv.v.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Heb|7|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.7.26">Heb. vii, 26</scripRef>. According to the sin of the people - In the same manner as
any of the people do; which implies that God expected more
circumspection from him, than from the people. But the words may be
rendered, to the sin or guilt of the people, which may be mentioned as
an aggrevation of his sin, that by it he commonly brings sin, and guilt,
and punishment upon the people, who are infected or scandalized by his
example. A young bullock - The same sacrifice which was offered for all
the people, to shew how much his sin was aggravated by his quality.
Sin-offering - Hebrew. sin, which word is oft taken in that sense.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p4">4. On the head - To testify both his acknowledgment of
his sin, and faith in God's promise for the expiation of his sins
through Christ, whom that sacrifice typified. Kill the bullock - By one
of the priests, whom he should cause to do it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p5">5. To the tabernacle - Into the tabernacle; which was not
required nor allowed in any other sacrifice, possibly to shew the
greatness of the high-priest's sin, which needed more than ordinary
diligence in him, and favour from God to expiate it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p6">6. Seven times - A number much used in scripture, as a
number of perfection; and here prescribed, either to shew that his sins
needed more then ordinary purgation, and more exercise of his faith and
repentance, both which graces he was obliged to join with that
ceremonial rite. Before the veil - The second veil dividing between the
holy of holies, which is generally called the veil of the sanctuary.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p7">7. All the blood - All the rest; for part was disposed
elsewhere.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p8">12. The whole bullock - So no part of this was to be
eaten by the priests, as it was in other sin-offerings. The reason is
plain, because the offerer might not eat of his own sin-offering, and
the priest was the offerer in this case, as also in the sin-offering for
the whole congregation below, of which the priest himself was a member.
Shall be carried forth - Not himself, which would have defiled him, but
by another whom he shall appoint for that work. Without the camp - To
signify either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.v.ii-p9">1. The abominable nature of sin, especially
in high and holy persons, or when it overspreads a whole people. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.v.ii-p10">2. The removing of the guilt or punishment
of that sin from the people. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.v.ii-p11">3. That Christ should suffer without the
camp or gate. Where the ashes are - For the ashes, though at first they
were thrown down near the altar, chap. i, 16, yet afterwards they,
together with the filth of the sacrifices, were carried into a certain
place without the camp.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p12">13. The whole congregation - The body of the people, or
the greater part of them, their rulers concurring with them.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p13">14. A bullock - But if the sin of the congregation was
only the omission of some ceremonial duty, a kid of the goats was to be
offered, <scripRef passage="Num. xv. 24" id="ii.iv.v.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Num|15|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.15.24">Num. xv, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p14">15. The elders - Who here acted in the name of all the
people, who could not possibly perform this act in their own
persons.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p15">17. And sprinkle it - It was not to be poured out there,
but sprinkled only; for the cleansing virtue of the blood of Christ was
sufficiently represented by sprinkling. It was sprinkled seven times:
seven is a number of perfection; because God made the world in six days,
and rested the seventh. This signified the perfect satisfaction Christ
made, and the compleat cleansing of our souls thereby.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p16">18. The altar - Of incense: Which is before the Lord -
That is, before the holy of holies, where the Lord was in a more special
manner present.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p17">20. For a sin-offering - That is, for the priest's
sin-offering, called the first bullock, ver. 21.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p18">24. The burnt-offering - So called by way of eminency, to
wit, the daily burnt-offering. It is a sin-offering - And therefore to
be killed where the burnt-offering is killed; whereby it is
distinguished from the peace-offering, which were killed elsewhere.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p19">26. It shall be forgiven - Both judicially, as to all
ecclesiastical censures or civil punishment; and really, upon condition
of repentance and faith in the Messiah to come.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p20">28. A female - Which here was sufficient, because the sin
of one of those was less than the sin of the ruler, for whom a male was
required.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p21">33. He shall slay it - Not by himself, but by the hands
of the priest.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.v.ii-p22">35. Burn them - The fat; but he useth the plural number,
because the fat was of several kinds, as we saw ver. 8, 9. upon the
offerings, together with them, or after them; because the burnt-
offerings were to have the first place.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="43.13%" prev="ii.iv.v.ii" next="ii.iv.vi.i" id="ii.iv.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. V" id="ii.iv.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="43.13%" prev="ii.iv.vi" next="ii.iv.vi.ii" id="ii.iv.vi.i">

<p id="ii.iv.vi.i-p1">Directions concerning trespass-offerings. Both this and
the sin- offering were intended to make atonement for sin, but the
former was more general: The latter was to be offered only in some
particular cases. If a man sinned, By hearing and concealing blasphemy,
ver. 1. By touching an unclean thing, ver. 2, 3.By swearing, ver. 4. He
was to offer a lamb or kid, ver. 5, 6. Or two young pigeons, ver. 7-10.
Or fine flour, ver. 11-13. Or a ram, if he had embezzled holy things,
ver. 14-19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="43.14%" prev="ii.iv.vi.i" next="ii.iv.vii" id="ii.iv.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p1">1. And hear - And for that is, as that particle is often
used. For this declares in particular what the sin was. Or, namely, that
of cursing, or blasphemy, or execration, as the word commonly signifies,
and that either against one's neighbour, or against God. This may seem
to be principally intended here, because the crime spoken of is of so
high a nature, that he who heard it, was obliged to reveal it, and
prosecute the guilty. He hath seen - Been present when it was said. Or
known - By sufficient information from others. His iniquity - That is,
the punishment of it; so that word is oft used, as <scripRef passage="Gen. xix. 15" id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|19|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.19.15">Gen. xix, 15</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Num. xviii. 1" id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Num|18|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.18.1">Num. xviii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p2">2. If it be hidden from him - If he do it unawares, yet
that would not excuse him, because he should have been more circumspect
to avoid all unclean things. Hereby God designed to awaken men to
watchfulness against, and repentance for, their unknown, or unobserved
sins. He shall be clean - Not morally, for the conscience was not
directly polluted by these things, but ceremonially.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p3">3. When he knoweth - As soon as he knoweth it, he must
not delay to make his peace with God. Otherwise he shall be guilty - For
his violation and contempt of God's authority and command.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p4">4. If a soul swear - Rashly, without consideration either
of God's law, or his own power or right, as David did, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxv. 22" id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Sam|25|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.25.22">1 Sam. xxv, 22</scripRef>. To do evil - To himself, to punish himself either in his
body, or estate, or something else which is dear to him. Or rather to
his neighbour. And it be hid from him - That is, he did not know, or not
consider, that what he swore to do, was or would be impossible, or
unlawful: When he discovers it to be so, either by his own
consideration, or by information from others, whether it was good or
evil which he swore to do.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p5">5. In one of these things - In one of the three
forementioned cases, either by sinful silence, or by an unclean touch,
or by rash swearing. He shall confess - Before the Lord in the place of
public worship. And this confession is not to be restrained to the
present case, but by a parity of reason, and comparing of other
scriptures, to be extended to other sacrifices for sin, to which this
was a constant companion.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p6">6. His trespass-offering - But how comes confession and a
sacrifice to be necessary for him that touched an unclean thing, when
such persons were cleansed with simple washing, as appears from chap.
xi, 25, 28, 32, 40, 43, and <scripRef passage="Num. xix. 7, 8, 10, 19" id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Num|19|7|19|8;|Num|19|10|0|0;|Num|19|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.19.7-Num.19.8 Bible:Num.19.10 Bible:Num.19.19">Num.
xix, 7, 8, 10, 19</scripRef>? This place speaks of him that being so unclean did come
into the tabernacle, as may be gathered by comparing this place with <scripRef passage="Num. xix. 13" id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Num|19|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.19.13">Num. xix,
13</scripRef>, which if any man did, knowing himself to be unclean, which
was the case there, he was to be cut off for it; and if he did it
ignorantly, which is the case here, he was upon discovery of it to offer
this sacrifice.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p7">7. Not able - Through poverty. And this exception was
allowed also in other sin-offerings. For a sin-offering - Which was for
that particular sin, and therefore offered first: before the burnt-
offering, which was for sins in general; to teach us not to rest in
general confessions and repentance, but distinctly and particularly, as
far as we can, to search out, and confess, and loath, and leave our
particular sins, without which God will not accept our other religious
services.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p8">9. It is a sin-offering - This is added as the reason why
its blood was so sprinkled and spilt.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p9">10. According to the manner - Or order appointed by God.
The priest shall make an atonement - Either declaratively, he shall
pronounce him to be pardoned; or typically, with respect to Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p10">11. The tenth part of an ephah - About six pints. He
shall put no oil, neither frankincense - Either to distinguish these
from the meal-offerings, chap. ii, 1, or as a fit expression of their
sorrow for their sins, in the sense whereof they were to abstain from
things pleasant; or to signify that by his sins he deserved to be
utterly deprived both of the oil of gladness, the gifts, graces and
comforts of the Holy Ghost; and of God's gracious acceptance of his
prayers and sacrifices, which is signified by incense, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xli,
2.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p11">13. As a meal offering - As it was in the meal-offering,
where all, except one handful, fell to the share of the priests. And
this is the rather mentioned here, because in the foregoing sacrifices,
chap. iv, 3, &amp;c. chap. iv, 13, &amp;c. the priest had no part
reserved for him.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p12">15. A trespass - Against the Lord and his priests.
Through ignorance - For if a man did it knowingly, he was to be cut off,
<scripRef passage="Num. xv. 30" id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Num|15|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.15.30">Num. xv, 30</scripRef>. In the holy things - In things consecrated to God, and to
holy uses; such as tithes and first-fruits, or any things due, or
devoted to God, which possibly a man might either with-hold, or employ
to some common use. A ram - A more chargeable sacrifice than the former,
as the sin of sacrilege was greater. With thy estimation - As thou shalt
esteem or rate it, thou, O priest; and at present, thou, O Moses, for he
as yet performed the priest's part. And this was an additional charge
and punishment to him; besides the ram, he was to pay for the holy thing
which he had with-held or abused, so many shekels of silver as the
priest should esteem proportionable to it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vi.ii-p13">17. The former law concerns the alienation of holy things
from sacred to common use; this may concern other miscarriages about
holy things, and holy duties, as may be gathered from ver. 19, where
this is said to be a trespass against the Lord, not in a general sense,
for so every sin was; but in a proper and peculiar sense.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="43.24%" prev="ii.iv.vi.ii" next="ii.iv.vii.i" id="ii.iv.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. VI" id="ii.iv.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="43.24%" prev="ii.iv.vii" next="ii.iv.vii.ii" id="ii.iv.vii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.vii.i-p1">Further directions concerning trespass-offerings, ver.
1-7. Concerning the burnt-offerings, ver. 8-13. Concerning the meal-
offerings, ver. 14-18. Particularly that at the consecration of the
priests, ver. 19-23. Concerning the sin-offering, ver. 24-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="43.24%" prev="ii.iv.vii.i" next="ii.iv.viii" id="ii.iv.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p1">2. If a soul sin - This sin, though directly committed
against man, is emphatically said to be done against the Lord, not only
in general, for so every sin against man is also against the Lord, but
in a special sense, because this was a violation of human society,
whereof God is the author, and president, and defender: and because it
was a secret sin, of which God alone was the witness and judge: and
because God's name was abused in it by perjury. To keep - In trust. Or
in fellowship - Hebrew. Or in putting of the hand: that is, commerce or
fellowship in trading, which is very usual when one man puts any thing
into another's hand, not to keep it, but to improve it for the common
benefit of them both, in which cases of partnership it is easy for one
to deceive the other, and therefore provision is made against it. And
this is called a putting of the hand, because such agreements used to be
confirmed by giving or joining their hands together. By violence -
Secretly; for he seems to speak here of such sins as could not be proved
by witness. Or hath deceived - Got any thing from him by calumny, or
fraud, or circumvention; so the word signifies.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p2">3. Swear falsely - His oath being required, seeing there
was no other way of discovery left.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p3">4. Is guilty - This guilt being manifested by his
voluntary confession upon remorse, whereby he reapeth this benefit, that
he only restores the principal with the addition of a fifth part;
whereas if he were convicted of his fault, he was to pay double, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxii. 9" id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Exod|22|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.22.9">Exod. xxii, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p4">5. In the day - It must not be delayed, but restitution
to man must accompany repentance towards God. Wherever wrong has been
done, restitution must be made, and till it is made to the utmost of our
power we cannot look for forgiveness; for the keeping of what is
unjustly got, avows the taking: And both together make but one continued
act of unrighteousness.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p5">9. And the Lord spake - Hitherto he hath prescribed the
sacrifices themselves; now he comes to the manner of them. The burnt-
offering - The daily one, which <scripRef passage="Exod. xxix. 38" id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Exod|29|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.29.38">Exod.
xxix, 38</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Num. xxviii. 3" id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p5.2" parsed="|Num|28|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.28.3">Num. xxviii,
3</scripRef>, as the following words shew. This was to be so managed and
laid on piece after piece, that the fire might be constantly maintained
by it. The morning burnt-offerings were to be kept burning all the day
from morning to night also; but he mentions not that, because there was
such a constant succession of sacrifices in the day-time that there
needed no law for feeding and keeping in the fire then; the only danger
was for the night, when other sacrifices were not offered, but only the
evening burnt-offering, which if it had been consumed quickly, as the
morning burnt-offering was, there had been danger of the going out of
that fire, which they were commanded diligently and constantly to keep
in.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p6">10. The ashes which the fire hath consumed - That is, the
wood consumed into ashes.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p7">11. Other garments - Because this was no sacred, but a
common work. A clean place - Where no dung or filth was laid. The priest
himself was to do all this. God's servants must think nothing below them
but sin.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p8">12. It shall not be put out - The fire coming down from
heaven, was to be perpetually preserved, and not suffered to go out,
partly that there might be no occasion or temptation to offer strange
fire; and partly to teach them whence they were to expect the acceptance
of all their sacrifices, even from the divine mercy, signified by the
fire that came down from heaven which was an usual token of God's
favourable acceptance. Every morning - Though the evening also be
doubtless intended, yet the morning is only mentioned, because then the
altar was cleansed, and the ashes taken away, and a new fire made.
Thereon - Upon the burnt- offering, which thereby would be sooner
consumed, that the way might be made for other sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p9">13. Thus should we keep the fire of holy love ever
burning in our hearts.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p10">14. Of the meal-offering - Of that which was offered
alone, and that by any of the people, not by the priest, for then it
must have been all burnt. This law before delivered, is here repeated
for the sake of some additions made to it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p11">16. His sons - The males only might eat these, because
they were most holy things; whereas the daughters of Aaron might eat
other holy things. In the court - In some special room appointed for
that purpose. The reason why this was to be eaten only by holy persons,
and that in an holy place, is given ver. 17, because it is most
holy.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p12">17. It - That part which remains to the priest; for the
part offered to God seems not to have been baked at all.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p13">18. Everyone - That is, none should touch, or eat them,
but consecrated persons, priests, or their sons.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p14">20. When he is anointed - For high-priest for he only of
all the priests was to be anointed in future ages. This law of his
consecration was delivered before, and is here repeated because of some
additions made to it. Perpetual - Whensoever any of them shall be so
anointed. At night - Or, in the evening; the one to be annexed to the
morning-sacrifice, the other to the evening- sacrifice, over and besides
that meal-offering which every day was to be added to the daily morning
and evening sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p15">21. Thou - Who art so anointed and consecrated.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p16">23. It shall not be eaten - No part of it shall be eaten
by the priest, as it was when the offering was for the people. The
reason of the difference is, partly because when he offered it for the
people, he was to have some recompence for his pains; partly to signify
the imperfection of the Levitical priest, who could not bear their own
iniquity; for the priest's eating part of the people's sacrifices did
signify his typical bearing of the people's iniquity; and partly to
teach the priests and ministers of God, that it is their duty to serve
God with singleness of heart, and to be content with God's honour though
they have no present advantage by it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p17">26. For sin - For the sins of the rulers, or of the
people, or any of them, but not for the sins of the priests; for then
its blood was brought into the tabernacle, and therefore it might not be
eaten.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p18">27. Upon any garment - Upon the priest's garment; for it
was he only that sprinkled it, and in so doing he might easily sprinkle
his garments. In the holy place - Partly out of reverence to the blood
of sacrifices, which hereby was kept from a profane or common touch; and
partly that such garments might be decent, and fit for sacred
administrations.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.vii.ii-p19">28. Broken - Because being full of pores, the liquor in
which it was sodden might easily sink into it, whereby it was
ceremonially holy, and therefore was broken, lest afterwards it should
be abused to common uses. Rinsed - And not broken, as being of
considerable value, which therefore God would not have unnecessarily
wasted. And this being of a more solid substance than an earthen vessel,
was not so apt to drink in the moisture.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="43.36%" prev="ii.iv.vii.ii" next="ii.iv.viii.i" id="ii.iv.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. VII" id="ii.iv.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="43.36%" prev="ii.iv.viii" next="ii.iv.viii.ii" id="ii.iv.viii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.viii.i-p1">Further directions, concerning the trespass-offering,
ver. 1-7. The burnt-offering and meal-offering, ver. 8-10. The peace-
offering, ver. 11-21. Fat and blood again forbidden, ver. 22-27. The
priest's share of it, ver. 28-34. The conclusion of these instructions,
ver. 35-38.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="43.37%" prev="ii.iv.viii.i" next="ii.iv.ix" id="ii.iv.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p1">7. So is - In the matter following, for in other things
they differed. The priests shall have it - That part of it, which was by
God allowed to the priest.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p2">9. All the meal-offering - Except the part reserved by
God, chap. ii, 2, 9. Because these were ready drest and hot, and to be
presently eaten; shall be the priests - The priest, who offered it, was
in reason to expect, something more than his brethren who laboured not
about it; and that he had only in this offering; for the others were
equally distributed.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p3">10. Dry - Without oil, or drink-offering, as those chap.
v, 11, <scripRef passage="Num. v. 15" id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Num|5|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.5.15">Num. v, 15</scripRef>. All the sons of Aaron - These were to be equally divided
among all the priests. And there was manifest reason for this
difference, because these were in greater quantity than the former; and
being raw, might more easily be reserved for the several priests to
dress it in that way which each of them liked.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p4">13. Leavened bread - Because this was a sacrifice of
another kind than those in which leaven was forbidden, this being a
sacrifice of thanksgiving for God's blessings, among which leavened
bread was one. Leaven indeed was universally forbidden, chap. ii, 11.
But that prohibition concerned only things offered and burnt upon the
altar, which this bread was not.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p5">14. Of it - That is, of the offering, one of each part of
the whole: it being most agreeable to the rules laid down before and
afterward, that the priest should have a share in the unleavened cakes
and wafers, as well as in the leavened bread.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p6">16. A vow - Offered in performance of a vow, the man
having desired some special favour from God, and vowed the sacrifice to
God if he would grant it. On the morrow also - Which was not allowed for
the thank-offering.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p7">18. Neither shall it be imputed - For an acceptable
service to God.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p8">19. And the flesh - Namely of the holy offering, of which
he is here treating; and therefore the general word is to be so limited;
for other flesh one might eat in this case. That toucheth - After its
oblation; which might easily happen, as it was conveyed from the altar
to the place where it was eaten: for it was not eaten in the holy place,
as appears, because it was eaten by the priests, together with the
offerers, who might not come thither. The flesh - That is, the other
flesh; that which shall not be polluted by any unclean touch. All that
are clean - Whether priests or offerers, or guests invited to the
feast.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p9">20. That eateth - Knowingly; for if it were done
ignorantly, a sacrifice was accepted for it. Not being cleansed from his
uncleanness according to the appointment, chap. xi, 24, &amp;c. This
verse speaks of uncleanness from an internal cause, as by an issue,
&amp;c. for what was from an external cause is spoken of in the next
verse.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p10">21. Of man - Or, of women, for the word signifies
both.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p11">23. The general prohibition of eating fat, chap. iii, 17,
is here explained of those kind of creatures which were sacrificed. The
fat of others they might eat.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p12">24. He speaks still of the same kinds of beasts, and
shews that this prohibition reaches not only to the fat of those beasts
which were offered to God, but also of those that died, or were killed
at home. And if this seems a superfluous prohibition, since the lean as
well as the fat of such beasts were forbidden, chap. xxii, 8, it must be
noted, that prohibition reached only to the priests, ver. 4.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p13">29. Shall bring - Not by another, but by himself, that
is, those parts of the peace-offering, which are in a special manner
offered to God. His oblation unto the Lord - That is, to the tabernacle,
where the Lord was present in a special manner. Though part of such
offerings might be eaten in any clean place, chap. x, 14, yet not till
they had been killed, and part of them offered to the Lord in the place
appointed by him for that purpose.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p14">30. His own hands - After the beast was killed, and the
parts of it divided, the priest was to put the parts mentioned into the
hands of the offerer. Offerings made by fire - So called, not strictly,
as burnt-offerings are, because some parts of these were left for the
priest, but more largely, because even these peace-offerings were in
part, tho' not wholly, burnt. Waved - To and fro, by his hands, which
were supported and directed by the hands of the priest.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p15">31. His sons - The portion of every succeeding
high-priest and his family.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p16">34. The wave-breast and heave-shoulder - The breast or
heart is the seat of wisdom, and the shoulder of strength for action;
and these two may denote that wisdom, and power, which were in Christ
our high-priest, and which ought to be in every priest.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p17">35. Of the anointing of Aaron - That is, of the
priesthood; the sign put for the thing signified; and the anointing by a
like figure is put for the part of the sacrifices belonging to the
priest by virtue of his anointing. This was their portion appointed them
by God in that day, and therefore to be given to them in after ages.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.viii.ii-p18">37. Of the consecrations - That is, of the sacrifice
offered at the consecration of the priests.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="43.46%" prev="ii.iv.viii.ii" next="ii.iv.ix.i" id="ii.iv.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. VIII" id="ii.iv.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="43.46%" prev="ii.iv.ix" next="ii.iv.ix.ii" id="ii.iv.ix.i">

<p id="ii.iv.ix.i-p1">This chapter gives an account of the consecration of
Aaron and his sins before the congregation, Moses washes and dresses
them, ver. 1-9. Anoints the tabernacle with its utensils, and Aaron,
ver. 10-12. Clothes his sons, ver. 13. Offers for them a sin- offering,
ver. 14-17. A burnt-offering, ver. 18-21. The ram of consecration, ver.
22-30. Declares to them God's charge, which they perform, ver.
31-36.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="43.46%" prev="ii.iv.ix.i" next="ii.iv.x" id="ii.iv.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p1">3. All the congregation - The elders who represented all,
and as many of the people as would, and could get thither, that all
might be witnesses both of Aaron's commission from God, and of his work
and business.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p2">12. He poured - In a plentiful manner, as appears from
<scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xxxiii, 2, whereas other persons and things were only sprinkled
with it: because his unction was to typify the anointing of Christ with
the Spirit, which was not given by measure to him. A measure of the same
anointing is given to all believers.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p3">14. The bullock - There were indeed seven bullocks to be
offered at his consecration, one every day; but here he mentions only
one, because he here describes only the work of the first day.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p4">17. His hide - Which in the offerings for the people was
not burnt, but given to the priest.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p5">18. He brought the ram - Hereby they gave to God the
glory of this great honour which was put upon them: and also signified
the devoting themselves and all their service to God.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p6">19. He - Either Moses, as in the following clause, or
some other person by his appointment; which may be the reason why he is
not named here, as he is to the sprinkling of the blood, which was an
action more proper to the priest, and more essential to the
sacrifice.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p7">29. Moses's part - Who at this time administering the
priest's office was to receive the priest's wages.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p8">31. The flesh - That which was left of the ram, and
particularly the breast, which was said to be Moses's part, ver. 29, and
by him was given to Aaron, that he and his sons might eat of it, in
token that they and only they should have the right to do so for the
future.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p9">33. Seven days - In each of which the same ceremonies
were to be repeated, and other rites to be performed. He - Either God or
Moses; for the words may be spoken by Moses, either in God's name or in
his own; Moses speaking of himself in the third person, which is very
common in scripture.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p10">36. So Aaron and his sons did all things - And thus the
covenant of life and peace, <scripRef passage="Mal. ii. 5" id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Mal|2|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mal.2.5">Mal. ii,
5</scripRef>, was made with them. But after all the ceremonies used in
their consecration, one point was reserved for the honour of Christ's
priesthood. They were made priests without an oath; but Christ with an
oath, <scripRef passage="Heb. vii. 21" id="ii.iv.ix.ii-p10.2" parsed="|Heb|7|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.7.21">Heb. vii, 21</scripRef>. For neither these priests, nor their priesthood was to
continue. But His is a perpetual and unchangeable priesthood.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="43.51%" prev="ii.iv.ix.ii" next="ii.iv.x.i" id="ii.iv.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. IX" id="ii.iv.x-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="43.51%" prev="ii.iv.x" next="ii.iv.x.ii" id="ii.iv.x.i">

<p id="ii.iv.x.i-p1">Moses appoints Aaron to offer various sacrifices, ver.
1-7. Aaron offers for himself, ver. 8-14. Offers for, and blesses the
people, ver. 15-22. God signifies his acceptance of their persons and of
their sacrifices, ver. 23-24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="43.51%" prev="ii.iv.x.i" next="ii.iv.xi" id="ii.iv.x.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p1">1. On the eighth day - Namely, from the day of his
consecration, or when the seven days of his consecration were ended. The
eighth day is famous in scripture for the perfecting and purifying both
of men and beasts. See chap. xii, 2, 3; xiv, 8, 9, 10; xv, 13, 14; xxii,
27. And the elders of Israel - All the congregation were called to be
witnesses of Aaron's installment into his office, to prevent their
murmurings and contempt; which being done, the elders were now
sufficient to be witnesses of his first execution of his office.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p2">2. For a sin-offering - For himself and his own sins,
which was an evidence of the imperfection of that priesthood, and of the
necessity of a better. The Jewish writers suggest, that a calf was
appointed, to remind him of his sin in making the golden calf. Thereby
he had rendered himself forever unworthy of the honour of the
priesthood: on which he had reason to reflect with sorrow and shame, in
all the atonements he made.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p3">3. A sin-offering - For the people, for whose sin a young
bullock was required, chap. iv, 15, but that was for some particular
sin; this was more general for all their sins. Besides, there being an
eye here to the priest's consecration and entrance into his office, it
is no wonder if there be some difference in these Sacrifices from those
before prescribed.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p4">4. The Lord will appear - Hebrew. Hath appeared. He
speaks of the thing to come as if it were past, which is frequent in
scripture, to give them the more assurance of the thing.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p5">5. Before the tabernacle where God dwelt.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p6">6. The glory of the Lord - The glorious manifestation of
God's powerful and gracious presence.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p7">7. Go and offer - Moses had hitherto sacrificed, but now
he resigns his work to Aaron, and actually gives him that commission
which from God he had received for him. For thyself and for the people -
The order is very observable, first for thyself, otherwise thou art
unfit to do it for the people. Hereby God would teach us, both the
deficiency of this priesthood, and how important it is that God's
ministers should be in the favour of God themselves, that their
ministrations may be acceptable to God, and profitable to the
people.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p8">9. The altar - Of burnt-offering, of which alone he
speaks both in the foregoing and following words; and the blood was
poured out at the bottom of this altar only, not of the altar of
incense, as appears from chap. iv, 7, where indeed there is mention of
putting some of the blood upon the horns of the altar of incense, in
this case of the priest's sacrificing for his own sins. But there seems
to be a double difference,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.x.ii-p9">1. That sacrifice was offered for some
particular sin, this for his sins indefinitely.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.x.ii-p10">2. There he is supposed to be compleat in
his office, and here he is but entering into his office, and therefore
must prepare and sanctify himself by this offering upon the brazen altar
in the court, before he can be admitted into the holy place where the
altar of incense was. And the like is to be said for the difference
between the sin-offering for the people here, and chap. iv, 17, 18.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p11">10. He burnt it - By ordinary fire, which was used until
the fire came down from heaven, ver. 24, though afterwards it was
forbidden. And if it had not been allowed otherwise, yet this being done
by Aaron at the command of Moses, and consequently with God's
approbation, it was unquestionably lawful. Add to this, that there is
nothing said to be consumed by that heavenly fire, but the
burnt-offering with the fat belonging to it, namely, that burnt-
offering mentioned ver. 16, which therefore is not there said to be
burnt, as it is said of the other burnt-offering, ver. 13, and of the
rest of the sacrifices in their places.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p12">16. The burnt-offering - Which also was offered for the
people, as the last mentioned sin-offering was.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p13">17. Besides the burnt-sacrifice - Which was to be first
offered every morning; for God will not have his ordinary and stated
service swallowed up by extraordinary.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p14">19. That - Fat. Which covereth the inwards - Or the
Guts.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p15">22. Aaron lifted up his hands - Which was the usual rite
of blessing. By this posture he signified both whence he expected the
blessing, and his hearty desire of it for them. And blessed them - In
some such manner, as is related, <scripRef passage="Num. vi. 24" id="ii.iv.x.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Num|6|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.6.24">Num.
vi, 24</scripRef>, &amp;c. though not in the same form, for it is not probable
that he used it before God delivered it And this blessing was an act of
his priestly office, no less than sacrificing. And herein be was a type
of Christ, who came into the world to bless us, and when he was parting
from his disciples, lifted up his hands and blessed them: yea, and in
them his whole church, of which they were the elders and
representatives. And came down - From the altar; whence he is said to
come down, either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.x.ii-p16">1. Because the altar stood upon raised
ground, or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.x.ii-p17">2. Because it was nearer the holy place,
which was the upper end.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p18">23. And Moses - Went in with Aaron to direct him, and to
see him perform those parts of his office which were to be done in the
holy place, about the lights, and the table of shew-bread, and the altar
of incense, upon which part of the blood of the sacrifices now offered
was to be sprinkled, chap. iv, 7, 16. And blessed the people - Prayed to
God for his blessing upon them, as this phrase is explained, <scripRef passage="Num. vi. 23" id="ii.iv.x.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Num|6|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.6.23">Num. vi, 23</scripRef>, &amp;c. and particularly for his gracious acceptation of
these and all succeeding sacrifices, and for his signification thereof
by some extraordinary token. And the glory of the Lord - Either a
miraculous brightness shining from the cloudy pillar, as <scripRef passage="Exod. xvi. 10" id="ii.iv.x.ii-p18.2" parsed="|Exod|16|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16.10">Exod. xvi, 10</scripRef>, or a glorious and visible discovery of God's gracious
presence and acceptance of the present service.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.x.ii-p19">24. And there came a fire - In token of God's approbation
of the priesthood now instituted, and the sacrifices offered, and
consequently of others of the like nature. And this fire now given was
to be carefully kept, and not suffered to go out, chap. vi, 13, and
therefore was carried in a peculiar vessel in their journeys in the
wilderness. From before the Lord - Or, from the presence of the Lord,
that is, from the place where God was in a special manner present,
either from heaven or from the holy of holies. They shouted - As
wondering at, rejoicing in, and blessing God for this gracious discovery
of himself, and his favour. This also was a figure of good things to
come. Thus the Spirit descended in fire upon the apostles, so ratifying
their commission, as this does that of the priests. And the descent of
this holy fire into our souls, to kindle in them devout affections, and
such an holy zeal as burns up all unholiness, is a certain token of
God's gracious acceptance.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="43.63%" prev="ii.iv.x.ii" next="ii.iv.xi.i" id="ii.iv.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. X" id="ii.iv.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="43.63%" prev="ii.iv.xi" next="ii.iv.xi.ii" id="ii.iv.xi.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xi.i-p1">The death of Nadab and Abihu, and quieting of Aaron, ver.
1-3. Orders given to bury them, and not to mourn, ver. 4-7. A command
not to drink wine or strong drink, and to distinguish between holy and
unholy, ver. 8-11. Directions concerning the parts of the
burnt-offerings which were to be eaten, ver. 12-15. Moses reproves the
priests, but is pacified by Aaron, ver. 16-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="43.63%" prev="ii.iv.xi.i" next="ii.iv.xii" id="ii.iv.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p1">1. Strange fire - Fire so called, because not taken from
the altar, as it ought, but from some common fire. Before the Lord -
Upon the altar of incense. Which he commanded not - Not commanding may
be here put for forbidding, as it is, <scripRef passage="Jer. xxxii. 35" id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Jer|32|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.32.35">Jer. xxxii, 35</scripRef>. Now as this was forbidden implicitly; chap. vi, 12,
especially when God himself made a comment upon that text, and by
sending fire from heaven declared of what fire he there spake; so it is
more than probable it was forbidden expressly, though that be not here
mentioned, nor was it necessary it should be.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p2">2. From the Lord - From heaven, or rather from the
sanctuary. Devoured them - Destroyed their lives; for their bodies and
garments were not consumed. Thus the sword is said to devour, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. ii. 26" id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Sam|2|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.2.26">2 Sam. ii, 26</scripRef>. Thus lightning many times kill persons, without any hurt to
their garments.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p3">3. The Lord spake - Though the words be not recorded in
scripture, where only the heads of discourses are contained, yet it is
probable they were uttered by Moses in God's name. Howsoever the sense
of them is in many places. I will be sanctified - This may note,
either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p4">1. their duty to sanctify God, to demean
themselves with such care, and reverence, and watchfulness, as becomes
the holiness of the God whom they serve; whence he leaves them to gather
the justice of the present judgment. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p5">2. God's purpose to sanctify himself, to
manifest himself to be an holy and righteous God by his severe and
impartial punishment of all transgressors, how near soever they are to
him. That come nigh me - Who draw near to me, or to the place where I
dwell, and are admitted into the holy place, whence others are shut out.
It is a description of the priests. I will be glorified - As they have
sinned publickly and scandalously, so I will vindicate my honour in a
public and exemplary manner, that all men may learn to give me the glory
of my holiness by an exact conformity to my laws. And Aaron held his
peace - In acknowledgment of God's justice and submission to it. He
murmured not, nor replied against God.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p6">4. Moses called Mishael - For Aaron and his sons were
employed in their holy ministrations, from which they were not called
for funeral solemnities. Brethren - That is, kinsmen, as that word is
oft used. Out of the camp - Where the burying-places of the Jews were,
that the living might neither be annoyed by the unwholesome scent of the
dead, nor defiled by the touch of their graves.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p7">5. In their coats - In the holy garments wherein they
ministered; which might be done, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p8">1. as a testimony of respect due to them,
notwithstanding their present failure; and that God in judgment
remembered mercy, and when he took away their lives, spared their souls.
Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p9">2. because being polluted both by their
sin, and by the touch of their dead bodies, God would not have them any
more used in his service.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p10">6. Uncover not your head - That is, give no signification
of your sorrow; mourn not for them; partly lest you should seem to
justify your brethren, and tacitly reflect upon God as too severe; and
partly lest thereby you should be diverted from, or disturbed in your
present service, which God expects to be done cheerfully. But bewail the
burning - Not so much in compassion to them, as in sorrow for the tokens
of divine displeasure.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p11">7. Ye shall not go from the tabernacle - Where at this
time they were, because this happened within seven days of their
consecration. The oil of the Lord is upon you - You are persons
consecrated peculiarly to God's service, which therefore it is just you
should prefer before all funeral solemnities.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p12">9. Drink not wine - it is not improbable, that the sin of
Nadab and Abihu was owing to this very thing. But if not, yet
drunkenness is so odious a sin in itself, especially in a minister, and
most of all in the time of his administration of sacred things, that God
saw fit to prevent all occasions of it. And hence the devil, who is
God's ape, required this abstinence from his priests in their idolatrous
service.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p13">10. Between holy and unholy - Persons and things, which
Nadab and Abihu did not.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p14">11. Ye may teach - Which drunken persons are very unfit
to do.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p15">12. Eat it - Moses repeats the command, partly lest their
grief should cause them to neglect their meat prescribed by God, (which
abstinence would have been both a signification of their sorrow which
God had forbidden them, and a new transgression of a divine precept;)
and partly to encourage them to go on in their holy services, and not to
be dejected, as if God would no more accept them or their
sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p16">13. In the holy place - in the court, near the altar of
burnt- offerings.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p17">14. In a clean place - In any of your dwellings, or any
place in the camp, which was kept clean from all ceremonial defilement.
In any place where the women as well as the men might come, for the
daughters of the priest might eat these as well as their sons, if they
were maids, or widows, or divorced, chap. xxii, 11-13.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p18">16. He was angry with Eleazar - He spares Aaron at this
time, as overwhelmed with sorrow, and because the rebuking him before
his sons might have exposed him to some contempt; but he knew that the
reproof though directed to them, would concern him too. Who were left
alive - And therefore ought to have taken warning.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p19">17. God hath given it to you - As a reward of your
service, whereby you expiate, bear, and take away their sins, by
offering those sacrifices, by which God through Christ is reconciled to
the penitent and believing offerers.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p20">18. The blood was not brought in - Because Aaron was not
yet admitted into the holy place, whither that blood should have been
brought, 'till he had prepared the way by the sacrifices which were to
be offered in the court.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p21">19. They have offered - They have done the substance of
the thing, though they have mistaken this one circumstance. Such things
- Whereby, haying been oppressed with grief, it is not strange nor
unpardonable if I have mistaked. Should it have been accepted - Because
it was not to be eaten with sorrow, but with rejoicing and
thanksgiving.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xi.ii-p22">20. He rested satisfied with his answer. it appeared,
that Aaron sincerely aimed at pleasing God: and those who do so, will
find he is not extreme to mark what is done amiss.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="43.74%" prev="ii.iv.xi.ii" next="ii.iv.xii.i" id="ii.iv.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XI" id="ii.iv.xii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="43.74%" prev="ii.iv.xii" next="ii.iv.xii.ii" id="ii.iv.xii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xii.i-p1">Of clean and unclean beasts, ver. 1-8. Fishes, ver. 9-12.
Fowls, ver. 13-19. Creeping things whether flying, ver. 20-28. or
creeping upon the earth, ver. 29-43. An exhortation to holiness, ver.
44, 45. The conclusion, ver. 46, 47.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="43.75%" prev="ii.iv.xii.i" next="ii.iv.xiii" id="ii.iv.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p1">1. From the laws concerning the priests, he now comes to
those which belong to all the people. God spake to both of them, because
the cognizance of the following matters belonged to both: the priest was
to direct the people about the things forbidden or allowed, where any
doubt or difficulty arose; and the magistrate was to see the direction
followed.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p2">2. These are the beasts - Though every creature of God be
good and pure in itself, yet it pleased God to make a difference between
clean and unclean, which he did in part before the flood, <scripRef passage="Gen. vii. 2" id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Gen|7|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.7.2">Gen. vii, 2</scripRef>, but more fully here for many reasons; as,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p3">1. To assert his own sovereignty over man,
and all the creatures which men may not use but with God's leave.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p4">2. To keep up the wall of partition between
the Jews and other nations, which was very necessary for many great and
wise purposes.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p5">3. That by bridling their appetite in
things in themselves lawful, and some of them very desirable, they might
be better prepared and enabled to deny themselves in things simply and
grossly sinful.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p6">4. For the preservation of their health,
some of the creatures forbidden being, though used by the neighbouring
nations, of unwholesome nourishment, especially to the Jews, who were
very obnoxious to leprosies. To teach them to abhor that filthiness, and
all those ill qualities for which some of these creatures are noted.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p7">3. Cloven-footed - That is, divided into two parts only:
This clause is added to explain and limit the former, as appears from
ver. 26, for the feet of dogs, cats &amp;c. are parted or cloven into
many parts. And cheweth the cud - Hebrew. and bringeth up the cud, that
is, the meat once chewed, out of the stomach in the mouth again, that it
may be chewed a second time for better concoction. And this branch is to
be joined with the former, both properties being necessary for the
allowed beasts. But the reason hereof must be resolved into the will of
the law-giver; though interpreters guess that God would hereby signify
their duties, by the first, that of discerning between good and evil;
and by the latter, that duty of recalling God's word to our minds and
meditating upon it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p8">4. The camel - An usual food in Arabia, but yielding bad
nourishment. Divideth not the hoof - So as to have his foot cloven in
two, which being expressed, ver. 3, is here to be understood. Otherwise
the camel's hoof is divided, but it is but a small and imperfect
division.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p9">5. As for the names of the following creatures, seeing
the Jews themselves are uncertain and divided about them, it seems
improper to trouble the unlearned readers with disputes about them.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p10">8. Ye shall not touch - Not in order to eating, as may be
gathered by comparing this with <scripRef passage="Gen. iii. 3" id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Gen|3|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.3.3">Gen.
iii, 3</scripRef>. But since the fat and skins of some of the forbidden
creatures were useful, for medicinal and other good purposes, and were
used by good men, it is not probable that God would have them cast away.
Thus God forbad the making of images, <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 4" id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p10.2" parsed="|Exod|20|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.4">Exod. xx, 4</scripRef>, not universally, but in order to the worshipping them, as
Christian interpreters agree.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p11">9. Fins and scales - Both of them; such fishes being more
cleanly, and more wholesome food than others. The names of them are not
particularly mentioned, partly because most of them wanted names, the
fish not being brought to Adam and named by him as other creatures were;
and partly because the land of Canaan had not many rivers, nor great
store of fish.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p12">11. Unto you - This clause is added to shew that they
were neither abominable in their own nature, nor for the food of other
nations; and consequently when the partition-wall between Jews and
Gentiles was taken away, these distinctions of meat were to cease.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p13">13. Among the fowls - The true signification of the
following Hebrew words is now lost, as the Jews at this day confess;
which not falling out without God's singular providence may intimate the
cessation of this law, the exact observation whereof since Christ came
is become impossible. In general, this may be observed, that the fowls
forbidden in diet, are all either ravenous and cruel, or such as delight
in the night and darkness, or such as feed upon impure things; and so
the signification of these prohibitions is manifest, to teach men to
abominate all cruelty or oppression, and all works of darkness and
filthiness. The ossifrage and the osprey - Two peculiar kinds of eagles,
distinct from that which being the chief of its kind, is called by the
name of the whole kind.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p14">15. After his kind - According to the several kinds,
known by this general name, which includes, besides ravens properly so
called, crows, rooks, pyes, and others.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p15">20. All fowls - Flying things that crawl or creep upon
the earth, and so degenerate from their proper nature, and are of a
mongrel kind, which may intimate that apostates and mongrels in religion
are abominable in the sight of God. Upon all four - Upon four legs, or
upon more than four, which is all one to the present purpose.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p16">22. The locust - Locusts, though unusual in our food,
were commonly eaten by the Ethiopians, Lybians, Parthians, and other
eastern people bordering upon the Jews. And as it is certain the eastern
locusts were much larger than ours, so it is probable they were of
different qualities, and yielding better nourishment.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p17">23. All other - That is, which have not those legs above
and besides their feet mentioned, ver. 21.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p18">24. Unclean - And such were excluded both from the court
of God's house, and from free conversation with other men.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p19">25. Beareth - Or, taketh away, out of the place where it
may lie, by which others may be either offended, or polluted.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p20">27. Upon his paws - Hebrew. upon his hands, that is,
which hath feet divided into several parts like fingers, as dogs, cats,
apes, and bears.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p21">34. That on which such water cometh - That flesh or herbs
or other food which is dressed in water, in a vessel so polluted, shall
be unclean; not so, if it be food which is eaten dry, as bread, or
fruits; the reason of which difference seems to be this, that the water
did sooner receive the pollution in itself, and convey it to the food so
dressed.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p22">36. Of this no reason can be given, but the will of the
law-giver and his merciful condescension to men's necessities, water
being scarce in those countries; and for the same reason God would have
the ceremonial law of sacrifices, give place to the law of mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p23">37. Seed - Partly because this was necessary provision
for man; and partly because such seed would not be used for man's food
till it had received many alterations in the earth whereby such
pollution was taken away.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p24">38. If any water - The reason of the difference is,
because wet seed doth sooner receive, and longer retain any pollution
and partly because such seed was not fit to be sown presently, and
therefore that necessity which justified the use of the dry seed, could
not be pretended in this case.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p25">39. If any beast die - Either of itself, or being killed
by some wild beast, in which cases the blood was not poured forth, as it
was when they were killed by men either for food or sacrifice.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p26">40. He that eateth - Unwittingly, for if he did it
knowingly, it was a presumptuous sin against an express law, <scripRef passage="Deut. xiv. 21" id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p26.1" parsed="|Deut|14|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.14.21">Deut. xiv, 21</scripRef>, and therefore punished with cutting off.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p27">41. Every creeping thing - Except those expressly
excepted, ver. 29, 30.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p28">42. Upon the belly - As worms and snakes, Upon all four -
As toads and divers serpents.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p29">44. Ye shall be holy - By this he gives them to
understand, that all these cautions about eating or touching these
creatures was not for any real uncleanness in them, but only that by
diligent observation of these rules they might learn with greater care
to avoid all moral pollutions, and to keep themselves from all
filthiness of flesh and spirit, and from all familiar and intimate
converse with notorious sinners.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p30">45. That bringeth you up out of Egypt - This was a reason
why they should cheerfully submit to distinguishing laws, who had been
so honoured with distinguishing favours.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p31">46. This is the law - It was so, as long the Mosaic
dispensation lasted. But under the gospel we find it expressly repealed
by a voice from heaven, <scripRef passage="Acts x. 15" id="ii.iv.xii.ii-p31.1" parsed="|Acts|10|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.10.15">Acts x,
15</scripRef>. Let us therefore bless God, that to us every creature of
God is good, and nothing to be refused.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="43.89%" prev="ii.iv.xii.ii" next="ii.iv.xiii.i" id="ii.iv.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XII" id="ii.iv.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="43.89%" prev="ii.iv.xiii" next="ii.iv.xiii.ii" id="ii.iv.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xiii.i-p1">Laws concerning the uncleanness of women in child-birth,
ver. 1-5. Concerning their purification, ver. 6-8.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="43.90%" prev="ii.iv.xiii.i" next="ii.iv.xiv" id="ii.iv.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xiii.ii-p1">1. From uncleanness contracted by the touching or eating
of external things, he now comes to that uncleanness which ariseth from
ourselves.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiii.ii-p2">2. Seven days - Not for any filthiness which was either
in the conception, or in bringing forth, but to signify the universal
and deep pollution of man's nature, even from the birth, and from the
conception. Seven days or thereabouts, nature is employed in the
purgation of most women. Her infirmity - Her monthly infirmity. And it
may note an agreement therewith not only in the time, chap. xv, 19, but
in the degree of uncleanness.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiii.ii-p3">4. In the blood of her purifying - In her polluted and
separated estate; for the word blood or bloods signifies both guilt, and
uncleanness, as here and elsewhere. And it is called the blood of her
purifying, because by the expulsion or purgation of that blood, which is
done by degrees, she is purified. No hallowed thing - She shall not eat
any part of the peace-offerings which she or her husband offered, which
otherwise she might have done; and, if she be a priest's wife, she shall
not eat any of the tythes or first fruits, or part of the hallowed
meats, which at other times she together with her husband might eat.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiii.ii-p4">5. Threescore and six days - The time in both particulars
is double to the former, not so much from natural causes, as to put an
honour upon the sacrament of circumcision, which being administered to
the males, did put an end to that pollution sooner than otherwise had
been.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiii.ii-p5">6. For a son or a daughter - For the birth of a son, or
of a daughter: but the purification was for herself, as appears from the
following verses. A sin-offering - Because of her ceremonial
uncleanness, which required a ceremonial expiation.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiii.ii-p6">8. The morality of this law obliges women who have
received mercies from God in child-bearing, with all thankfulness to
acknowledge his goodness to them, owning themselves unworthy of it, and
(which is the best purification) to continue in faith, and love, and
holiness, with sobriety.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="43.93%" prev="ii.iv.xiii.ii" next="ii.iv.xiv.i" id="ii.iv.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XIII" id="ii.iv.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="43.93%" prev="ii.iv.xiv" next="ii.iv.xiv.ii" id="ii.iv.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.i-p1">Rules whereby the priest was to judge of the leprosy,
ver. 1- 44. Directions concerning the leper, ver. 45, 46. Concerning the
leprosy in garments, ver. 47-59.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="43.93%" prev="ii.iv.xiv.i" next="ii.iv.xv" id="ii.iv.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p1">2. In the skin - For there is the first seat of the
leprosy, the bright spot shining like the scale of a fish, as it is in
the beginning of a leprosy. The priest - The priest was to admit to, or
exclude from, the sanctuary, and therefore to examine who were to be
excluded.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p2">3. When the hair is turned white - This change of colour
was an evidence both of the abundance of excrementious humours, and of
the weakness of nature, as we see in old and sick persons. His flesh -
For the leprosy consumed both the skin and the flesh.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p3">4. Seven days - For greater assurance; to teach ministers
not to be hasty in their judgments, but diligently to search and examine
all things before-hand. The plague is here put for the man that hath the
plague.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p4">6. Dark - Contrary to the white colour of the leprosy.
But the word may be rendered, have contracted itself, and thus the
opposition seems to be most clear as the spreading of itself. He shall
wash his clothes - Though it was no leprosy, to teach us, that no sin is
so small as not to need to be washed by the blood of Christ, which was
the thing designed by all these washings.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p5">10. White in the skin - With a preternatural and
extraordinary whiteness. Raw flesh - This shewed it was not a
superficial leprosy but one of a deeper and more malignant nature, that
had eaten into the very flesh, for which cause it is in the next verse
called an old or inveterate leprosy.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p6">13. All his flesh - When it appeared in some one part it
discovered the ill humour which lurked within, and withal the inability
of nature to expel it; but when it overspread all, it manifested the
strength of nature conquering the distemper, and purging out the ill
humours into the outward parts.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p7">14. In it - That is in the place where the appearance of
leprosy was, when the flesh was partly changed into a whiter colour, and
partly kept its natural colour, this variety of colours was an evidence
of the leprosy, as one and the same colour continuing, was a sign of
soundness.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p8">15. The raw flesh - This is repeated again and again,
because raw or living flesh might rather seem a sign of soundness, and
the priest might easily be deceived by it, and therefore he was more
narrowly to look into it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p9">16. Unto white - As it is usual with sores, when they
begin to be healed, the skin which is white, coming upon the flesh.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p10">21. Dark - Or, and be contracted.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p11">22. A plague - Or the plague of leprosy, of which he is
speaking.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p12">24. A hot burning - A burning of fire, by the touch of
any hot- iron, or burning coals, which naturally makes an ulcer or sore
in which the following spot is.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p13">28. Of the burning - Arising from the burning mentioned,
ver. 24.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p14">30. A yellow, thin hair - The leprosy in the body turned
the hair white, in the head or beard it turned it yellow. And if a man's
hair was yellow before, this might easily be distinguished from the
rest, either by the thinness or smallness of it, or by its peculiar kind
of yellow, for there are divers kinds of the same colour manifestly
differing from one another.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p15">31. No black hair - For had that appeared, it had ended
the doubt, the black hair being a sign of soundness and strength of
nature, as the yellow hair was a sign of unsoundness.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p16">33. He shall be shaven - For the more certain discovery
of the growth or stay of the plague.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p17">36. He shall not seek - He need not search for the hair,
or any other sign, the spreading of it being a sure sign of leprosy.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p18">39. If the spots be darkish white - Or, contracted, or
confined to the place where they are, and white.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p19">42. It is a leprosy - It is a sign that such baldness
came not from age, or any accident, but from the leprosy.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p20">45. His clothes shall be rent - In the upper and fore
parts, which were most visible. This was done partly as a token of
sorrow, because though this was not a sin, yet it was an effect of sin,
and a sore punishment, whereby he was cut off both from converse with
men, and from the enjoyment of God in his ordinances; partly as a
warning to others to keep at a due distance from him wheresoever he
came. And his head bare - Another sign of mourning. God would have men
though not overwhelmed with, yet deeply sensible of his judgments. A
covering on his upper lip - Partly as another badge of his sorrow and
shame, and partly for the preservation of others from his breath or
touch. Unclean, unclean - As begging the pity and prayers of others, and
confessing his own infirmity, and cautioning those who came near him, to
keep at a distance from him.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p21">46. He shall dwell alone - Partly for his humiliation;
partly to prevent the infection of others; and partly to shew the danger
of converse with spiritual lepers, or notorious sinners.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p22">47. Leprosy in garments and houses is unknown in these
times and places, which is not strange, there being some diseases
peculiar to some ages and countries. And that such a thing was among the
Jews, cannot reasonably be doubted; for, if Moses had been a deceiver, a
man of his wisdom, would not have exposed himself to the contempt of his
people by giving laws about that which their experience shewed to be but
a fiction.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p23">48. In the warp or woof - A learned man renders it in the
outside, or in the inside of it. If the signification of these words be
doubtful now, as some of those of the living creatures and precious
stones are confessed to be, it is not material to us, this law being
abolished; it sufficeth that the Jews understood these things by
frequent experience.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xiv.ii-p24">55. If it have not changed its colour - If washing doth
not take away that vicious colour, and restore it to its own native
colour.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="44.03%" prev="ii.iv.xiv.ii" next="ii.iv.xv.i" id="ii.iv.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XIV" id="ii.iv.xv-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="44.03%" prev="ii.iv.xv" next="ii.iv.xv.ii" id="ii.iv.xv.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xv.i-p1">The manner of cleansing a leper, ver. 1-9. The sacrifices
to be offered for him, ver. 10-32. The management of an house suspected
of leprosy, ver. 33-53. The summary of the whole, ver. 54-57.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="44.04%" prev="ii.iv.xv.i" next="ii.iv.xvi" id="ii.iv.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p1">2. He shall be brought to the priest - Not into the
priest's house, but to some place without the camp or city, which the
priest shall appoint.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p2">3. Healed by God-For God alone did heal or cleanse him
really, the priest only declaratively.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p3">4. Two birds - The one to represent Christ as dying for
his sins, the other to represent him as rising again for his
purification or justification. Clean - Allowed for food and for
sacrifice. Cedar- wood - A stick of cedar, to which the hyssop and one
of the birds was tied by the scarlet thread. Cedar seems to be chosen,
to note that the leper was now freed from that corruption which his
leprosy had brought upon him, that kind of wood being in a manner
incorruptible. Scarlet - A thread of wool of a scarlet colour, to
represent both the leper's sinfulness, and the blood of Christ, and the
happy change of the leper's colour and complexion, which before was wan
and loathsome, now sprightly and beautiful. Hyssop - The fragrant smell
of which, signified the cure of the leper's ill scent.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p4">5. Killed - By some other man. The priest did not kill it
himself, because it was not properly a sacrifice, as being killed
without the camp, and not in that place to which all sacrifices were
confined. In an earthen-vessel - That is, over running water put in an
earthen-vessel - Thus the blood of the bird and the water were mixed
together, partly for the conveniency of sprinkling, and partly to
signify Christ, who came by water and blood, <scripRef passage="1 John v. 6" id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1John|5|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1John.5.6">1 John v, 6</scripRef>. The running water, that is, spring or river water by its
liveliness and motion did fitly signify the restoring of liveliness to
the leper, who was in a manner dead before.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p5">7. Into the open field - The place of its former abode,
signifying the taking off that restraint which was laid upon the
leper.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p6">8. All his hair - Partly to discover his perfect
soundness; partly to preserve him from a relapse through any relicks of
it which might remain in his hair or in his clothes. Out of his tent -
Out of his former habitation, in some separate place, lest some of his
leprosy yet lurking in him should break forth to the infection of his
family.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p7">9. All his hair - Which began to grow again, and now for
more caution is shaved again.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p8">10. Oil is added as a fit sign of God's grace and mercy,
and of the leper's healing. A log is a measure containing six egg-shells
full.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p9">11. Maketh him clean - The healing is ascribed to God,
ver. 13, but the ceremonial cleansing was an act of the priest using the
rites which God had prescribed.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p10">12. A trespass-offering - To teach them, that sin was the
cause of leprosy, and of all diseases, and that these ceremonial
observations had a farther meaning, to make them sensible of their
spiritual diseases, that they might fly to God in Christ for the cure of
them.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p11">14. The priest shall put it - To signify, that he was now
free to hear God's word in the appointed places, and to touch any person
or thing without defiling it, and to go whither he pleased.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p12">15. The oil - As the blood signified Christ's blood by
which men obtained remission of sins, so the oil noted the graces of the
spirit by which they are renewed.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p13">16. Before the Lord - Before the second veil which
covered the holy of holies.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p14">17. Upon the blood - Upon the place where that blood was
put.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p15">25. The priest shall put the blood - Upon the extremities
of the body, to include the whole. And some of the oil was afterwards
put in the same places upon the blood. That blood seems to have been a
token of forgiveness, the oil of healing: For God first forgiveth our
iniquities, and then healeth our diseases. When the leper was anointed,
the oil must have blood under it, to signify that all the graces and
comforts of the spirit, all his sanctifying influences are owing to the
death of Christ. It is by his blood alone that we are sanctified.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p16">36. That all be not made unclean - It is observable here,
that neither the people nor the household stuff were polluted till the
leprosy was discovered and declared by the priest, to shew what great
difference God makes between sins of ignorance, and sins against
knowledge.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p17">37. In the walls of the house - This was an extraordinary
judgment of God peculiar to this people, either as a punishment of their
sins, which were much more sinful and inexcusable than the sins of other
nations; or as a special help to repentance, which God afforded them
above other people; or as a token of the mischievous nature of sin,
typified by leprosy, which did not only destroy persons, but their
habitations also: Hollow streaks - Such as were in the bodies of leprous
persons.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p18">40. An unclean place - Where they used to cast dirt and
filthy things.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xv.ii-p19">57. To teach - To direct the priest when to pronounce a
person or house clean or unclean. So it was not left to the priests
power or will, but they were tied to plain rules, such as the people
might discern no less than the priest.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="44.12%" prev="ii.iv.xv.ii" next="ii.iv.xvi.i" id="ii.iv.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XV" id="ii.iv.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="44.12%" prev="ii.iv.xvi" next="ii.iv.xvi.ii" id="ii.iv.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.i-p1">This chapter contains laws concerning other ceremonial
uncleannesses, contracted either by bodily disease, or some natural
incidents, whether in men, ver. 1-18, or in women, ver. 19- 33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="44.13%" prev="ii.iv.xvi.i" next="ii.iv.xvii" id="ii.iv.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p1">2. A running issue - Commonly called the running of the
reins, a grievous and loathsome disease, which is generally the
consequence of sin.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p2">3. His flesh be stopped - That is, if it have run, and be
stopped in great measure, either by the grossness of the humour, or by
some obstructions that it cannot run freely.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p3">7. The flesh - That is, any part of his body.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p4">11. And hath not rinsed - That is, the person touched, to
whom the washing of his hands is prescribed, if speedily done; but if
that was neglected, a more labourious course was enjoined.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p5">13. When he is cleansed - When his issue hath wholly
ceased.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p6">15. An atonement - Not as if this was in itself a sin,
but only a punishment of sin; though oft-times it was sinful, as being a
fruit of intemperance.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p7">18. A man - Or, The man, that had such an issue, which is
plainly to be understood out of the whole context. For though in some
special cases relating to the worship of God, men were to forbear the
use of the marriage-bed, yet to affirm that the use of it in other cases
did generally defile the persons, and make them unclean till even, is
contrary to the whole current of scripture, which affirms the
marriage-bed to be undefiled, <scripRef passage="Heb. xiii. 4" id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Heb|13|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.13.4">Heb.
xiii, 4</scripRef>, to the practice of the Jews, which is a good comment upon
their own laws, and to the light of nature and reason.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p8">19. And if a woman - Hebrew. And a woman when she shall
have an issue of blood, and her issue shalt be in her flesh, that is, in
her secret parts, as flesh is taken, ver. 2. So it notes her monthly
disease. Put apart - Not out of the camp, but from converse with her
husband and others, and from access to the house of God. Seven days -
For sometimes it continues so long; and it was decent to allow some time
for purification after the ceasing of her issue. Whosoever toucheth her
- Of grown persons. For the infant, to whom in that case she might give
suck, was exempted from this pollution by the greater law of necessity,
and by that antecedent law which required women to give suck to their
own children.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p9">24. Seven days - If he did this ignorantly; but if the
man and woman did this knowingly, being accused and convicted, they were
punished with death, chap. xx, 18, for as there was a turpitude in the
action, so it was very prejudicial to the children then begotten, who
were commonly weak, or leprous; which was also an injury to the
commonwealth of Israel, and redounded to the dishonour of God and of the
true religion, that the professors thereof gave such public evidence of
their intemperance.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p10">28. Seven days - From the stopping of her issue. And this
was for trial, whether it was only a temporary obstruction, or a real
cessation.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvi.ii-p11">31. When they defile my tabernacle - Both ceremonially,
by coming into it in their uncleanness, and morally by the contempt of
God's express command to cleanse themselves. The grand reason of all
these laws was, to separate the children of Israel from their
uncleanness. Hereby they were taught their privilege and honour, that
they were purified unto God, a peculiar people; for that was a
defilement to them, which was not so to others. They were also taught
their duty, which was to keep themselves clean from all pollutions.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="44.18%" prev="ii.iv.xvi.ii" next="ii.iv.xvii.i" id="ii.iv.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XVI" id="ii.iv.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="44.18%" prev="ii.iv.xvii" next="ii.iv.xvii.ii" id="ii.iv.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.i-p1">The institution of the yearly day of atonement for the
whole nation. The whole service is committed to the high-priest, who
is,</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.i-p2">1. Then only to come into the holy of holies, in his
linen garments with a young bullock, ver. 1-4.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.i-p3">2. To offer a goat, and a bullock for a sin-offering,
ver. 5-13.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.i-p4">3. To sprinkle the blood before the mercy seat, and upon
the altar, ver. 13-19.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.i-p5">4. To confess over the scape-goat, the sins of the
people, and then send him into the wilderness, ver. 20-23.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.i-p6">5. To offer the burnt-offerings, ver. 24-28. And,</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.i-p7">6. To appoint this day to be a solemn fast, by a statute
forever, ver. 29-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="44.19%" prev="ii.iv.xvii.i" next="ii.iv.xviii" id="ii.iv.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p1">2. At all times - Not whensoever he pleaseth, but only
when I shall appoint him, namely, to take down the parts and furniture
of it upon every removal, and to minister unto me once in the year. Lest
he die - For his irreverence and presumption. In the cloud - In a bright
and glorious cloud, over the mercy-seat, as a token when I would have
him come.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p2">3. With a young bullock - That is, with the blood of it;
the body of it was to be offered upon the altar of burnt-offerings. A
sin- offering - For his own and family's sins; for a goat was offered
for the sins of the people.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p3">4. The linen coat - It is observable, the high-priest did
not now use his peculiar and glorious robes, but only his linen
garments, which were common to him with the ordinary priests. The reason
whereof was, because this was not a day of feasting and rejoicing, but
of mourning and humiliation, at which times people were to lay aside
their ornaments. These are holy - Because appropriated to an holy and
religious use.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p4">8. For the Lord - For the Lord's use by way of sacrifice.
Both this and the other goat typified Christ; this in his death and
passion for us; that in his resurrection for our deliverance.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p5">11. The bullock - Mentioned in general, ver. 6. The
ceremonies whereof are here particularly described. This was a different
bullock or heifer from that <scripRef passage="Num. xix. 2, 5, 9, 10, 17" id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Num|19|2|0|0;|Num|19|5|0|0;|Num|19|9|0|0;|Num|19|10|0|0;|Num|19|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.19.2 Bible:Num.19.5 Bible:Num.19.9 Bible:Num.19.10 Bible:Num.19.17">Num. xix, 2, 5, 9, 10,
17</scripRef>, as appears by comparing the places.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p6">12. Within the veil - That is, into the holy of holies,
ver. 2.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p7">13. Upon the fire - Which was in the censer, ver. 12.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p8">14. Upon the mercy-seat - To teach us, that God is
merciful to sinners only through and for the blood of Christ. With his
face east-ward, or upon the eastern part, towards the people, who were
in the court which lay east-ward from the holy of holies, which was the
most western part of the tabernacle. This signified that the high-priest
in this act represented the people, and that God accepted it on their
behalf. Before the mercy-seat - On the ground.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p9">15. Then shall he kill the goat - He went out of the holy
of holies, and killed it, and then returned thither again with its
blood. And whereas the high-priest is said to be allowed to enter into
that place but once in a year, that is to be understood, but one day in
a year, though there was occasion of going in and coming out more than
once upon that day.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p10">16. Because of the uncleannesses of Israel - For though
the people did not enter into that place, yet their sins entered
thither, and would hinder the effects of the high-priest's mediation on
their behalf if God was not reconciled to them. In the midst of their
uncleanness - ln the midst of a sinful people, who defile not themselves
only, but also God's sanctuary. And God hereby shewed them, how much
their hearts needed to be purified, when even the tabernacle, only by
standing in the midst of them, needed this expiation.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p11">17. In the tabernacle - ln the holy place, where the
priests and Levites were at other times. This was commanded for the
greater reverence to the Divine Majesty then in a more special manner
appearing, and that none of them might cast an eye into the holy of
holies, as the high-priest went in or came out.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p12">18. The altar before the Lord - That is, the altar of
incense, where the blood of sacrifices was to be put, particularly the
blood of the sin-offerings offered upon this day of atonement, and which
is most properly said to be before the Lord, that is, before the place
where God in a special manner dwelt. His going out relates to the holy
of holies, into which he was said to go in, ver. 17.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p13">19. Seven times - To signify its perfect cleansing,
(seven being a number of perfection) and our perfect reconciliation by
the blood of Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p14">21. All the iniquities - He mentions iniquities,
transgressions, and sins, to note sins of all sorts, and that a free and
full confession was to be made, and that the smallest sins needed, and
the greatest sins were not excluded from, the benefit of Christ's death
here represented. On the head - Charging all their sins and the
punishment due to them upon the goat, which tho' only a ceremony, yet
being done according to God's appointment and manifestly pointing at
Christ upon whom their iniquities and punishments were laid, <scripRef passage="Isaiah liii. 5, 6" id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Isa|53|5|53|6" osisRef="Bible:Isa.53.5-Isa.53.6">Isaiah liii, 5, 6</scripRef>, it was available for this end. And hence the Heathens took
their custom of selecting one beast or man, upon whom they laid all
their imprecations and curses, and whom they killed as an expiatory
sacrifice for their sins, and to prevent their ruin. A fit man - Hebrew.
a man of time, that is, of years and discretion, who may be trusted with
this work. Into the wilderness - Which signified the removal of their
sins far away both from the people, and out of God's sight. And here the
goat being neglected by all men, and exposed to many hazards from wild
beasts, which were numerous there, might further signify Christ's being
forsaken both by God and by men, even by his own disciples, and the many
dangers and sufferings he underwent. The Jews write, that this goat was
carried to the mountain called Azazel, whence the goat is so called,
ver. 10, and that there he was cast down headlong.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p15">24. He shall put on his linen garments - Not his ordinary
priestly linen garments, for he was to leave them in the tabernacle,
ver. 23, but the high-priestly garments, called his garments properly,
and by way of distinction. And this change of his garments was not
without cause. For the common priestly garments were more proper for him
in the former part of his ministration, both because he was to appear
before the Lord in the most holy place to humble himself and make
atonement for his own and for the people's sins, and therefore his
meanest attire was most fit, and because he was to lay his hands upon
that goat on which all their sins were put, by which touch both he and
his garments would be in some sort defiled, and therefore as he washed
himself, so we may presume his linen garments were laid by for the
washing, as the clothes of him who carried away the scape-goat were
washed, ver. 26. And the high-priestly garments were most proper for the
latter part of his work, which was of another nature.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p16">29. The seventh month - Answering part to our September
and part to our October; when they had gathered in all their fruits, and
were most at leisure for God's service: This time God chose for this and
other feasts, herein graciously condescending to men's necessities and
conveniences. This feast began in the evening of the ninth day, and
continued till the evening of the tenth. Your souls - Yourselves, both
your bodies, by abstinence from food and other delights, and your minds
by grief for former sins, which though bitter, yet is voluntary in all
true penitents, who are therefore here said to afflict themselves, or to
be active in the work.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p17">31. A sabbath - Observed as a sabbath-day from all
servile works, and diligent attendance upon God's worship.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p18">32. He - The high-priest, who was to anoint his
successor.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xvii.ii-p19">34. This shall be an everlasting statute - By which were
typified the two great gospel privileges; remission of sins, and access
to God, both which we owe to the mediation of the Lord Jesus.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="44.32%" prev="ii.iv.xvii.ii" next="ii.iv.xviii.i" id="ii.iv.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XVII" id="ii.iv.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="44.32%" prev="ii.iv.xviii" next="ii.iv.xviii.ii" id="ii.iv.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.i-p1">Two prohibitions,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.xviii.i-p2">1. That no sacrifice be offered by any but
the priests, nor any where but at the door of the tabernacle, ver.
1-9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.xviii.i-p3">2. That no blood be eaten, ver. 10-16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="44.32%" prev="ii.iv.xviii.i" next="ii.iv.xix" id="ii.iv.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p1">3. That killeth-Not for common use, for such beasts might
be killed by any person or in any place but for sacrifice. In the camp,
or out of the camp - That is, anywhere.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p2">4. The tabernacle - This was appointed in opposition to
the Heathens, who sacrificed in all places; to cut off occasions of
idolatry; to prevent the people's usurpation of the priest's office, and
to signify that God would accept of no sacrifices but through Christ and
in the Church; (of both which the tabernacle was a type.) But though men
were tied to this law, God was free to dispense with his own law, which
he did sometimes to the prophets, as <scripRef passage="1 Sam. vii. 9" id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|1Sam|7|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.7.9">1
Sam. vii, 9</scripRef>, xi, 15. He hath shed blood - He shall be punished as a
murderer. The reason is, because he shed that blood, which, though not
man's blood, yet was precious, being sacred and appropriated to God, and
typically the price by which men's lives were ransomed.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p3">5. They offer - The Israelites, before the building of
the tabernacle, did so, from which they are now restrained. Peace-
offerings - He nameth not these exclusively from others, as appears from
the reason of the law, and from ver. 8, 9, but because in these the
temptation was more common in regard of their frequency, and more
powerful, because part of these belonged to the offerer, and the
pretense was more plausible, because their sanctity was of a lower
degree than others, these being only called holy, and allowed in part to
the people, whereas the others are called most holy, and were wholly
appropriated either to God, or to the priests.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p4">6. Upon the altar - This verse contains a reason of the
foregoing law, because of God's propriety in the blood and fat,
wherewith also God was well pleased, and the people reconciled. And
these two parts only are mentioned, as the most eminent, and peculiar,
though other parts also were reserved for God.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p5">7. Unto devils - So they did, not directly or
intentionally, but by construction and consequence, because the devil is
the author of idolatry, and is eminently served, and honoured by it. And
as the Egyptians were notorious for their idolatry, so the Israelites
were infected with their leaven, <scripRef passage="Josh. xxiv. 14" id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Josh|24|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.24.14">Josh. xxiv, 14</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Ezek. xx. 7" id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p5.2" parsed="|Ezek|20|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.20.7">Ezek. xx, 7</scripRef>, xxiii, 2, 3. A whoring - Idolatry, especially in God's
people, is commonly called whoredom, because it is a violation of that
covenant by which they were peculiarly betrothed or married to God.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p6">10. I will set my face - I will be an enemy to him, and
execute vengeance upon him immediately; because such persons probably
would do this in private, so that the magistrate could not know nor
punish it. Write that man undone, forever undone, against whom God sets
his face.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p7">11. Is in the blood - Depends upon the blood, is
preserved and nourished by it. The blood maketh atonement - Typically,
and in respect of the blood of Christ which it represented, by which the
atonement is really made. So the reason is double;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p8">1. because this was eating up the ransom of
their own lives, which in construction was the destroying of
themselves.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p9">2. because it was ingratitude and
irreverence towards that sacred blood of Christ which they ought to have
in continual veneration.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p10">15. That eateth - Through ignorance or inadvertency; for
if it was done knowingly, it was more severely punished. A stranger -
Who is a proselyte to the Jewish religion: other strangers were allowed
to eat such things, <scripRef passage="Deut. xiv. 21" id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Deut|14|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.14.21">Deut. xiv,
21</scripRef>, out of which the blood was either not drawn at all, or not
regularly.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xviii.ii-p11">16. His iniquity - The punishment of it, and therefore
must offer a sacrifice for it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="44.39%" prev="ii.iv.xviii.ii" next="ii.iv.xix.i" id="ii.iv.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XVIII" id="ii.iv.xix-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="44.39%" prev="ii.iv.xix" next="ii.iv.xix.ii" id="ii.iv.xix.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xix.i-p1">A prohibition of conformity to the heathens, ver. 1-5.
Particular laws against incest, ver. 6-18. Against unnatural lusts and
barbarous idolatries, ver. 19-23. Enforced from the destruction of the
Canaanites, ver. 24-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="44.39%" prev="ii.iv.xix.i" next="ii.iv.xx" id="ii.iv.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p1">2. Your God - Your sovereign, and lawgiver. This is often
repeated because the things here forbidden were practiced and allowed by
the gentiles, to whose custom he opposes divine authority and their
obligation to obey his commands.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p2">3. Egypt and Canaan - These two nations he mentions,
because their habitation and conversation among them made their evil
example in the following matters more dangerous. But under them he
includes all other nations.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p3">4. My judgments - Though you do not see the particular
reason of some of them, and though they be contrary to the laws and
usages of the other nations.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p4">5. He shall live in them - Not only happily here, but
eternally hereafter. This is added as a powerful argument why they
should follow God's commands, rather than mens examples, because their
life and happiness depend upon it. And though in strictness, and
according to the covenant of works they could not challenge life for so
doing, except their obedience was universal, perfect, constant and
perpetual, and therefore no man since the fall could be justified by the
law, yet by the covenant of grace this life is promised to all that obey
God's commands sincerely.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p5">6. To uncover their nakedness - I think Mark. Free has
made it highly probable, that this phrase does not mean marriage, but
fornication, throughout this chapter. So it unquestionably means in the
twentieth chapter.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p6">16. Thy brother's wife - God afterwards commanded, that
in one case, a man should marry his brother's widow.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p7">18. Thou shalt not take a wife to her sister - Perhaps
this text doth not simply forbid the taking one wife to another, but the
doing it in such a manner or for such an end, that he may vex or punish,
or revenge himself of the former; which probably was a common motive
amongst that hardhearted people to do so.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p8">19. As long as she is set apart - No not to thy own wife.
This was not only a ceremonial pollution, but an immorality also, whence
it is put amongst gross sins, <scripRef passage="Ezek. xviii. 6" id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ezek|18|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.18.6">Ezek.
xviii, 6</scripRef>. And therefore it is now unlawful under the gospel.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p9">21. Pass through fire - This was done, either by burning
them in the fire, or by making them pass between two great fires, which
was a kind of consecration of them to that God. Moloch - Called also
Milcom, was an idol chiefly of the Ammonites. He seems to be the Saturn
of the heathens, to whom especially children and men were sacrificed.
This is mentioned, because the neighbours of Israel were most infected
with this idolatry, and therefore they are particularly cautioned
against it, though under this one instance all other idols and acts, or
kinds of idolatry, are manifestly comprehended and forbidden.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p10">25. I visit - I am about to visit, that is, to
punish.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p11">26. Nor any stranger - In nation or religion, of what
kind soever. For though they might not force them to submit to their
religion, yet they might restrain them from the publick contempt of the
Jewish laws, and from the violation of natural laws, which, besides the
offense against God and nature, were matters of evil example to the
Israelites themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xix.ii-p12">29. Cut off - This phrase therefore of cutting off, is to
be understood variously, either of ecclesiastical, or civil punishment,
according to the differing natures of the offenses for which it is
inflicted.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="44.45%" prev="ii.iv.xix.ii" next="ii.iv.xx.i" id="ii.iv.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XIX" id="ii.iv.xx-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="44.45%" prev="ii.iv.xx" next="ii.iv.xx.ii" id="ii.iv.xx.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xx.i-p1">Various Precepts to be holy, ver. 1, 2. To honour parents
and sabbaths, ver. 3. To shun idolatry, ver. 4. Duty to eat their
peace-offering, ver. 5- 8. To leave gleanings for the poor, ver. 9, 10.
Not to steal, lie, swear falsely, or defraud, ver. 11-13. Not to curse
the deaf, or put a stumbling-block before the blind, ver. 14. Not to
judge unjustly, carry tales, or bear false witness, ver. 15, 16. To
reprove sinners, not to revenge themselves; to love their neighbours,
ver. 17, 18. Not to mix different things, ver. 19. Not to lie with their
bond- maids, ver. 20-22. Not to eat of the fruit of the land for four
years, ver. 23-25. Not to eat blood, use enchantments, or heathen
customs, ver. 26-28. Or prostitute their daughters, ver. 29. To
reverence God and his sanctuary, ver. 30. Not to regard wizards, ver.
31. To honour the aged, ver. 32. Love and right the stranger, ver. 33,
34. Do no injustice, ver. 34, 35, 36.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="44.47%" prev="ii.iv.xx.i" next="ii.iv.xxi" id="ii.iv.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p1">2. Be ye holy - Separated from all the forementioned
defilements, and entirely consecrated to God and obedient to all his
laws. I am holy - Both in my essence, and in all my laws, which are holy
and just and good.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p2">3. His mother - The mother is put first, partly because
the practice of this duty begins there, mothers, by perpetual converse,
being sooner known to their children than their fathers; and partly
because this duty is commonly neglected to the mother, upon whom
children have not so much dependence as they have upon their father. And
this fear includes the two great duties of reverence and obedience. And
keep my sabbaths - This is added, to shew, that, whereas it is enjoined
to parents that they should take care the sabbath be observed both by
themselves and their children, it is the duty of children to fear and
obey their parents in this matter. But that, if parents should neglect
their duty herein, or by their command, counsel, or example, draw them
to pollute the sabbath, the children in that case must keep the sabbath,
and prefer the command of God before the commands of their parents.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p3">4. Idols - The word signifies such as are no Gods, or
nothings, as they are called, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. viii. 4" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p3.1" parsed="|1Cor|8|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.8.4">1 Cor.
viii, 4</scripRef>, many idols having no being, but in the fancy of their
worshippers, and all of them having no virtue or power to do good or
evil, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xli. 23" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p3.2" parsed="|Isa|41|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.41.23">Isaiah xli,
23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p4">5. At your own will - Or, according to your own pleasure,
what you think fit: For though this in general was required, yet it was
left to their choice to determine the particulars.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p5">6. On the morrow - He speaks here of that sort of
peace-offerings, which were offered either by vow or freely for the
obtaining of some mercy, for the other sort, which was by way of
gratitude for mercies received, were to be eaten the same day.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p6">10. I am the Lord your God - Who gave you all these
things with a reservation of my right in them, and with a charge of
giving part of them to the poor.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p7">12. Ye shall not swear falsely - This is added, to shew
how one sin draws on another, and that when men will lye for their own
advantage, they will easily be induced to perjury. Profane the name - By
any unholy use of it. So it is an additional precept, thou shalt not
abuse my holy name by swearing either falsely or rashly.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p8">14. Before the blind - To make them fall. Under these two
particulars are manifestly forbidden all injuries done to such as are
unable to right or defend themselves; of whom God here takes the more
care, because they are not able to secure themselves. Fear thy God - Who
both can and will avenge them.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p9">15. The poor - So as through pity to him to give an
unrighteous sentence.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p10">16. Stand against the blood - In judgment as a false
accuser or false witness, for accusers and witnesses use to stand,
whilst the Judges sit in courts of judicature.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p11">17. Thou shalt not hate - As thou dost, in effect, if
thou dost not rebuke him. Thy brother - The same as thy neighbour, that
is, every man. If thy brother hath done wrong, thou shalt neither
divulge it to others, nor hate him, and smother that hatred by sullen
silence; nor flatter him therein, but shalt freely and in love, tell him
of his fault. And not suffer sin upon him - Not suffer him to lie under
the guilt of any sin, which thou by rebuking him, and thereby bringing
him to repentance, couldst free him from.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p12">18. Thy neighbour - Every man, as plainly appears,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p13">1. By comparing this place with ver. 34,
where this law is applied to strangers.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p14">2. Because the word neighbour is explained
by another man, chap. xx, 10 <scripRef passage="Rom. xiii. 8" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Rom|13|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.13.8">Rom. xiii,
8</scripRef>. As thyself - With the same sincerity, though not equality
of affection.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p15">19. Thou shalt not let thy cattle gender - This was
prohibited, partly to restrain the curiosity and boldness of men, who
might attempt to amend or change the works of God, partly that by the
restraint here laid even upon brute-creatures men might be taught to
abhor all unnatural lusts, partly to teach the Israelites to avoid
mixtures with other nations, either in marriage or in religion, which
also may be signified by the following prohibitions.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p16">20. She shall be scourged - Hebrew. There shall be a
scourging, which probably may belong to both of them, for</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p17">1. Both were guilty.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p18">2. It follows, they shall not be punished
with death, which may seem to imply that they were to be punished by
some other common and considerable punishment, which scourging indeed
was, but the paying of a ram was a small penalty and very unsuitable to
the greatness of the offense. And the offering of the ram as a trespass
offering for the sin against God, is not inconsistent with making
satisfaction other ways for the injury done to men, but only added here
as farther punishment to the man, either because he only could do this,
and not the woman, who being a bondwoman had nothing of her own to
offer. Or because his sex and his freedom aggravated his sin. Not put to
death - Which they should have been, had she been free, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxii. 23, 24" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Deut|22|23|22|24" osisRef="Bible:Deut.22.23-Deut.22.24">Deut. xxii, 23, 24</scripRef>. The reason of this difference is not from any respect which
God gives to persons, for bond and free are alike to him, but because
bond-women were scarce wives, and their marriages were scarce
true-marriages, being neither made by their choice, but their masters
authority, nor continued beyond the year of release, but at her master's
or husband's pleasure.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p19">23. As uncircumcised - That is, As unclean, not to be
eaten but cast away. This precept was serviceable,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p20">1. To the trees themselves, which grew the
better and faster, being early stript of those fruits, which otherwise
would have drawn away much more of the strength from the tree.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p21">2. To men, both because the fruit then was
less wholesome, and because hereby men were taught to bridle their
appetites; a lesson of great use and absolute necessity in a holy
life.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p22">24. Holy - Consecrated to the Lord, as the first-fruits
and tithes were, and therefore given to the priests and Levites, <scripRef passage="Num. xviii. 12, 13" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p22.1" parsed="|Num|18|12|18|13" osisRef="Bible:Num.18.12-Num.18.13">Num. xviii, 12, 13</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Deut. xviii. 4" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p22.2" parsed="|Deut|18|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.18.4">Deut. xviii, 4</scripRef> yet so that part of them were communicated to the poor
widows and fatherless and strangers. See <scripRef passage="Deut. xiv. 28" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p22.3" parsed="|Deut|14|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.14.28">Deut. xiv, 28</scripRef>. To bless the Lord, by whose power and goodness the trees
bring forth fruit to perfection.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p23">25. That it may yield the increase - That God may be
pleased to give his blessing, which alone can make them fruitful.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p24">26. Any thing with the blood - Any flesh out of which the
blood is poured. Neither shall ye use enchantments - It was unpardonable
in them, to whom were committed the oracles of God, to ask counsel of
the devil. And yet worse in Christians, to whom the son of God is
manifested, to destroy the works of the devil. For Christians to have
their nativities cast, or their fortunes told, or to use charms for the
cure of diseases, is an intolerable affront to the Lord Jesus, a support
of idolatry, and a reproach both to themselves, and to that worthy name
by which they are called. Nor observe times - Superstitiously, esteeming
some days lucky, others unlucky.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p25">27. The corners of your heads - That is your temples, ye
shall not cut off the hair of your heads round about your temples. This
the Gentiles did, either for the worship of their idols, to whom young
men used to consecrate their hair, being cut off from their heads, as
Homer, Plutarch and many others write; or in funerals or immoderate
mournings, as appears from <scripRef passage="Isaiah xv. 2" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p25.1" parsed="|Isa|15|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.15.2">Isaiah xv,
2</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Jer. xlviii. 37" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p25.2" parsed="|Jer|48|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.48.37">Jer. xlviii, 37</scripRef>. And the like is to be thought concerning the beard or the
hair in the corner, that is, corners of the beard. The reason then of
this prohibition is because God would not have his people agree with
idolaters, neither in their idolatries, nor in their excessive
sorrowing, no nor so much as in the appearances of it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p26">28. Cuttings in your flesh - Which the Gentiles commonly
did both in the worship of their idols, and in their solemn mournings, <scripRef passage="Jer. xvi. 6" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p26.1" parsed="|Jer|16|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.16.6">Jer. xvi, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p27">29. Do not prostitute - As the Gentiles frequently did
for the honour of some of their idols, to whom women were consecrated,
and publickly prostituted.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p28">31. Wizards - Them that have entered into covenant with
the devil, by whose help they foretel many things to come, and acquaint
men with secret things. See ver. 27 <scripRef passage="Deut. xviii. 11" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p28.1" parsed="|Deut|18|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.18.11">Deut. xviii, 11</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxviii. 3, 7, 9" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p28.2" parsed="|1Sam|28|3|0|0;|1Sam|28|7|0|0;|1Sam|28|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.28.3 Bible:1Sam.28.7 Bible:1Sam.28.9">1 Sam. xxviii, 3, 7, 9</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="2 Kings xxi. 6" id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p28.3" parsed="|2Kgs|21|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.21.6">2 Kings xxi,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p29">32. Rise up - To do them reverence when they pass by, for
which end they were obliged, as the Jews say, presently to sit down
again when they were past, that it might be manifest they arose out of
respect to them. Fear thy God - This respect is due to such, if not for
themselves, yet for God's sake, who requires this reverence, and whose
singular blessing old age is.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p30">33. Vex him - Either with opprobrious expressions, or
grievous exactions.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p31">34. As one born among you - Either 1, as to the matters
of common right, so it reacheth to all strangers. Or 2, as to church-
privileges, so it concerns only those who were proselytes. Ye were
strangers - And therefore are sensible of the fears, distresses, and
miseries of such, which call for your pity, and you ought to do to them,
as you desired others should do to you, when you were such.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p32">35. In mete-yard - In the measuring of lands, or dry
things, as cloth, ribband. In measure - In the measuring liquid or such
dry things as are only contigious, as corn or wine.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p33">36. A just ephah and a just hin - These two two measures
are named as most common, the former for dry, the latter for moist
things, but under them he manifestly comprehends all other measures.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xx.ii-p34">37. Therefore - Because my blessings and deliverances are
not indulgences to sin, but greater obligations to all duties to God and
men.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="44.63%" prev="ii.iv.xx.ii" next="ii.iv.xxi.i" id="ii.iv.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XX" id="ii.iv.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="44.63%" prev="ii.iv.xxi" next="ii.iv.xxi.ii" id="ii.iv.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.i-p1">Prohibitions against offering children to Moloch, ver.
1-5. Against consulting wizards, ver. 6. Holiness enjoined, ver. 7, 8.
Against cursing parents, ver. 9. Against adultery, ver. 10 Against
incestuous mixtures, ver. 11-21. Holiness again enjoined, ver. 22- 26.
Soothsayers to be stoned, ver. 27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="44.64%" prev="ii.iv.xxi.i" next="ii.iv.xxii" id="ii.iv.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p1">2. The people - Here follow the punishments of the crimes
forbidden in the former chapters.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p2">3. I will set my face against that man - Deal with him as
an enemy, and make him a monument of my justice. To defile my sanctuary
- Because the sanctuary was defiled by gross abominations committed in
that city or land where God's sanctuary was: or because by these actions
they declared to all men that they esteemed the sanctuary and service of
God abominable and vile, by preferring such odious idolatry before it.
And to profane my name - Partly by despising it themselves, partly by
disgracing it to others, and giving them occasion to blaspheme it, and
to abhor the true religion.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p3">4. Hide their eyes - Wink at his fault, and forbear to
accuse and punish him.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p4">6. To go a whoring - To seek counsel or help from
them.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p5">8. Who sanctify you - Who separate you from all nations,
and from their impurities and idolatries, to be a peculiar people to
myself; and who give you my grace to keep my statutes.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p6">9. Curseth - This is not here meant of every perverse
expression, but of bitter reproaches or imprecations. His blood shall be
upon him - He is guilty of his own death: he deserves to die for so
unnatural a crime.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p7">12. Confusion - By perverting the order which God hath
appointed, and making the same off-spring both his own child and his
grandchild.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p8">13. Put to death - Except the one party was forced by the
other. See <scripRef passage="Deut. xxii. 25" id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Deut|22|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.22.25">Deut. xxii,
25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p9">14. They - All who consented to it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p10">15. Slay the beast - Partly for the prevention of
monstrous births, partly to blot out the memory of so loathsome a
crime.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p11">17. See her nakedness - In this and several of the
following verses, uncovering nakedness plainly appears to mean not
marriage, but fornication or adultery.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p12">20. They shall die childless - Either shall be speedily
cut off ere they can have a child by that incestuous conjunction; if
this seem a less crime than most of the former incestuous mixtures, and
therefore the magistrate forbear to punish it with death; yet they shall
either have no children from such an unlawful bed, or their children
shall die before them.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p13">21. His brother's wife - Except in the case allowed by
God, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 5" id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Deut|25|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.5">Deut. xxv, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxi.ii-p14">27. A man or a woman that hath a familiar spirit, shall
surely be put to death - They that are in league with the devil, have in
effect made a covenant with death: and so shall their doom be.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="44.68%" prev="ii.iv.xxi.ii" next="ii.iv.xxii.i" id="ii.iv.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XXI" id="ii.iv.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="44.68%" prev="ii.iv.xxii" next="ii.iv.xxii.ii" id="ii.iv.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.i-p1">Directions to the priests, ver. 1-9. To the high-priest,
ver. 10- 15. None of these must have any blemish, ver. 16-24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="44.68%" prev="ii.iv.xxii.i" next="ii.iv.xxiii" id="ii.iv.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p1">1. Among his people - None of the priests shall touch the
dead body, or assist at his funeral, or eat of the funeral feast. The
reason of this law is evident, because by such pollution they were
excluded from converse with men, to whom by their function they were to
be serviceable upon all occasions, and from the handling of holy things.
And God would hereby teach them, and in them all successive ministers,
that they ought entirely to give themselves to the service of God. Yea,
to renounce all expressions of natural affection, and all worldly
employments, so far as they are impediments to the discharge of their
holy services.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p2">2. Near to him - Under which general expression his wife
seems to be comprehended, though she be not expressed. And hence it is
noted as a peculiar case, that Ezekiel, who was a priest, was forbidden
to mourn for his wife, <scripRef passage="Ezek. xxiv. 16" id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Ezek|24|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.24.16">Ezek. xxiv,
16</scripRef>, &amp;c. These exceptions God makes in condescension to
human infirmity, because in such cases it was very hard to restrain the
affections. But this allowance concerns only the inferior priest, not
the high- priest.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p3">3. That is nigh him - That is, by nearness not of
relation, (for that might seem a needless addition) but of habitation,
one not yet cut off from the family. For if she was married, she was now
of another family, and under her husband's care in those matters.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p4">4. Being - Or, seeing he is a chief man, for such not
only the high- priest, but others also of the inferior priests were. He
shall not defile himself for any other person whatsoever. To profane
himself - Because such defilement for the dead did profane him, or make
him as a common person, and consequently unfit to manage his sacred
employment.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p5">5. They shall not make baldness - In funerals, as the
Heathens did. Though I allow them to defile themselves for some of the
dead, yet in no case shall they use these superstitious rites, which
also the people were forbidden to do; but the priests in a more peculiar
manner, because they are by word and example to teach the people their
duty.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p6">6. Holy unto their God - Devoted to God's service, and
always prepared for it, and therefore shall keep themselves from all
defilements. The name of their God - Which they especially bear. The
bread of their God - That is, the shew-bread: or rather, all the other
offerings, besides burnt-offerings: which are called bread, because
bread is commonly put for all food.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p7">7. Profane - Or defiled, or deflowered, though it were
done secretly, or by force: because the priest must take care that all
the members of his family be free not only from gross wickedness, but
from all suspicions of evil.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p8">8. Thou - O Moses, and whosoever shall succeed in thy
place, to whom it belongs to see my laws observed, shall take care that
the priest be holy, and do not defile himself by any of these forbidden
marriages.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p9">9. And the daughter - And by analogy his son also, and
his wife, because the reason of the law here added, concerns all. And
nothing is more common than to name one kind for the rest of the same
nature, as also is done chap. xviii, 6. She profaneth her father -
Exposeth his person and office, and consequently religion, to
contempt.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p10">10. The garments - Those holy garments, which were
peculiar to him. Shall not uncover his head - This being then the
posture of mourners, chap. x, 6, though afterwards the custom was
changed and mourners covered their heads, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xv. 30" id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|2Sam|15|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.15.30">2 Sam. xv, 30</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Esth vi. 12" id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p10.2" parsed="|Esth|6|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.6.12">Esth vi, 12</scripRef>. Nor rent his clothes - Another expression of mourning.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p11">11. Go in - Into the chamber or house where they lie.
This and divers other rites here prescribed were from hence translated
by the Heathens into their use, whose priests were put under the same
obligations.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p12">12. Out of the sanctuary - To attend the funerals of any
person: for upon other occasions he might and did commonly go out. Nor
profane the sanctuary - Either by the performance of a civility, or by
entering into the sanctuary before the seven days allotted for his
cleansing, <scripRef passage="Num. xix. 11" id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Num|19|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.19.11">Num. xix, 11</scripRef>, were expired. The crown of the anointing oil - Or, the
crown, the golden plate, which is called the holy crown, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxix. 6" id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p12.2" parsed="|Exod|29|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.29.6">Exod. xxix, 6</scripRef>, and the anointing oil of his God are upon him. So there is
only an ellipsis of the conjunction and, which is frequent. And these
two things, being most eminent, are put for the rest, as the sign is put
for the thing signified, that is, for he is God's high-priest.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p13">13. In her virginity - Or, a virgin, partly because as he
was a type of Christ, so his wife was a type of the church, which is
compared to a virgin, and partly for greater caution and assurance that
his wife was not a defiled or deflowered person. Most of these things
are forbidden to all the priests; and here to the high-priest, to shew
that he also, and he especially is obliged to the same cautions.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p14">15. I the Lord sanctify him - I have separated him from
all other men for my immediate service, and therefore will not have that
race corrupted.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p15">17. Of thy seed - Whether the high priest, or the
inferior ones. That hath - In all successive ages, any defect or excess
of parts, any notorious deformity or imperfection in his body. The
reason hereof is partly typical, that he, might more fully represent
Christ, the great high-priest, who was typified both by the priest and
sacrifice, and therefore both were to be without blemish; partly moral,
to teach all Christians and especially ministers of holy things, what
purity and perfection of heart and life they should labour after, and
that notorious blemishes in the mind or conversation, render a man unfit
for the ministry of the gospel; and partly prudential, because such
blemishes were apt to breed contempt of the person; and consequently, of
his function, and of the holy things wherein he ministered. For which
reason, such persons as have notorious defects or deformities, are still
unfit for the ministry except where there are eminent gifts and graces,
which vindicate a man from the contemptibleness of his bodily presence.
The particular defect's here mentioned, I shall not enlarge upon because
some of the Hebrew words are diversely interpreted, and because the use
of these things being abolished, the knowledge of them is not
necessary.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p16">18. A flat nose - Most restrain this word to the nose,
and to some great deformity relating to it. But according to others, it
signifies more generally, a person that wants some member or members,
because the next word, to which it is opposed, signifies one that hath
more members than he should.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p17">21. A blemish - Any notorious blemish whereby he is
disfigured, though not here mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p18">22. He shall eat - Which a priest having any uncleanness
might not do whereby God would shew the great difference between natural
infirmities sent upon a man by God, and moral defilements which a man
brought upon himself.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxii.ii-p19">23. To the veil - To the second veil which was between
the holy and the most holy place, to burn incense, to order the
shew-bread, and to dress the lamps, which were nigh unto that veil
though without. My altar - The altar of burnt-offering, which was
without the sanctuary. The sense is, he shall not execute the priest's
office, which was to be done in those two places.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="44.81%" prev="ii.iv.xxii.ii" next="ii.iv.xxiii.i" id="ii.iv.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XXII" id="ii.iv.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="44.81%" prev="ii.iv.xxiii" next="ii.iv.xxiii.ii" id="ii.iv.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.i-p1">A priest, having any uncleanness, must not eat of the
holy things, ver. 1-7. No priest must eat that which dies of itself, or
is torn, ver. 8, 9. No stranger must eat of holy things, ver. 10-13. Of
them that do it ignorantly, ver. 14-16. Sacrifices must be without
blemish, and of a due age, ver. 17-27. Thank offerings must be eaten the
same day, ver. 29, 30. An exhortation to obedience, ver. 31-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXII" progress="44.82%" prev="ii.iv.xxiii.i" next="ii.iv.xxiv" id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p1">2. Separate themselves - When any uncleanness is upon
them, as appears from ver. 3, 4. From the holy things - From eating of
those parts of the offerings, which belong to them. Only of the tithes
they might eat. They - The children of Israel. And it ill became the
priests to profane or pollute what the people did hallow.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p2">3. Goeth unto the holy things - To eat them, or to touch
them; for if the touch of one of the people having his uncleanness upon
him defiled the thing he touched, much more was it so in the priest. Cut
off - From my ordinances by excommunication: He shall be excluded both
from the administration, and from the participation of them.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p3">7. His food - His portion, the means of his subsistence.
This may be added, to signify why there was no greater nor longer a
penalty put upon the priests than upon the people in the same case,
because his necessity craved some mitigation: tho' otherwise the priests
being more sacred persons, deserved a greater punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p4">9. Lest they bear sin - Incur guilt and punishment. For
it - For the neglect or violation of it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p5">10. No stranger - Of a strange family, who is not a
priest; but there is an exception to this rule, ver. 11. A sojourner -
One that comes to his house and abides there for a season, and eats at
his table.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p6">12. A stranger - To one of another family, who is no
priest. Yet the priest's wife, though of another family, might eat. The
reason of which difference is, because the wife passeth into the name,
state and privileges of her husband, from whom the family is
denominated.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p7">14. Unto it - Over and above the principle, and besides
the ram to be offered to God, chap. v, 15. And shall give unto the
priest the holy thing - That is, the worth of it, which the priest was
either to take to himself or to offer to God, as the nature of the thing
was.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p8">15. They - The people shall not profane them, by eating
them: or the priests shall not profane them, that is, suffer the people
to profane them, without censure and punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p9">16. They - That is, the priests, shall not (the negative
particle being understood out of the foregoing clause) suffer them -
That is, the people, to bear the iniquity of trespass - That is, the
punishment of their sin, which they might expect from God, and for the
prevention whereof the priest was to see restitution made.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p10">18. Strangers - Such as were proselytes.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p11">19. A male - For a burnt-offering, which was always of
that kind: but the females were accepted in peace-offerings, and sin-
offerings.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p12">25. A stranger's hand - From proselytes: even from those,
such should not be accepted, much less from the Israelites. The bread of
your God - That is, the sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p13">28. In one day - Because it favoured of cruelty.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiii.ii-p14">32. Hallowed, or sanctified, either by you in keeping my
holy commands, or upon you in executing my holy and righteous judgments.
I will manifest myself to be an holy God that will not bear the
transgression of my laws.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="44.87%" prev="ii.iv.xxiii.ii" next="ii.iv.xxiv.i" id="ii.iv.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XXIII" id="ii.iv.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xxiv-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="44.87%" prev="ii.iv.xxiv" next="ii.iv.xxiv.ii" id="ii.iv.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.i-p1">Directions concerning the sabbath, ver. 1-3. The
passover, ver. 4-8. The first fruits, ver. 9-14. The feast of pentecost,
ver. 15- 22. of trumpets, ver. 23-25. Of atonement, ver. 26-32. Of
tabernacles, ver. 33-44.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="44.87%" prev="ii.iv.xxiv.i" next="ii.iv.xxv" id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p1">2. Ye shall proclaim - Cause to be proclaimed, by the
priests. Holy convocations - Days for your assembling together to my
worship in a special manner.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p2">3. Ye shall do no work therein - So it runs in the
general for the sabbath day, and for the day of expiation, ver. 28,
excluding all works about earthly employments whether of profit or of
pleasure; but upon other feast days he forbids only servile works, as
ver. 7, 21, 36, for surely this manifest difference in the expressions
used by the wife God must needs imply a difference in the things. In all
your dwellings - Other feasts, were to be kept before the Lord in
Jerusalem only, whither all the males were to come for that end; but the
sabbath was to be kept in all places, both in synagogues, and in their
private houses.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p3">4. These are the feasts of the Lord - Or rather, the
solemnities: (for the day of atonement was a fast:) and so the word is
used, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxxiii. 20" id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Isa|33|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.33.20">Isaiah xxxiii, 20</scripRef>, where Zion is called the city of our solemnities.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p4">10. An omer - They did not offer this corn in the ear, or
by a sheaf or handful, but, as Josephus, 3. 10 affirms, and may be
gathered from chap. ii, 14, 15, 16, purged from the chaff, and dryed,
and beaten out.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p5">11. He shall wave the sheaf before the Lord - In the name
of the whole congregation, which as it were sanctified to them the whole
harvest, and gave them a comfortable use of all the rest. For then we
may eat our bread with joy, when God hath accepted our works. And thus
should we always begin with God; begin our lives with him, begin every
day with him, begin every work and business with him: seek ye first the
kingdom of God. The morrow after the sabbath - After the first day of
the feast of unleavened bread, which was a sabbath or day of rest, as
appears from ver. 7, or upon the sixteenth day of the month. And this
was the first of those fifty days, in the close whereof was the feast of
pentecost.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p6">13. Two tenth deals - Or, parts, of an ephah, that is,
two omers, whereas in other sacrifices of lambs there was but one tenth
deal prescribed. The reason of which disproportion may be this, that one
of the tenth deals was a necessary attendant upon the lamb, and the
other was peculiar to this feast, and was an attendant upon that of the
corn, and was offered with it in thanksgiving to God for the fruits of
the earth.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p7">14. Bread - Made of new wheat. Nor green ears - Which
were usual, not only for offerings to God, but also for man's food.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p8">15. From the morrow - From the sixteenth day of the
month, and the second day of the feast of unleavened bread
inclusively.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p9">16. A new meal-offering - Of new corn made into
loaves.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p10">18. One bullock and two rams - In <scripRef passage="Num. xxviii. 11, 19" id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Num|28|11|0|0;|Num|28|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.28.11 Bible:Num.28.19">Num. xxviii, 11, 19</scripRef>, it is two young bullocks and one ram. Either therefore it
was left to their liberty to chuse which they would offer, or one of the
bullocks there, and one of the rams here, were the peculiar sacrifices
of the feast day, and the other were attendants upon the two loaves,
which were the proper offering at this time. And the one may be
mentioned there, and the other here, to teach us, that the addition of a
new sacrifice did not destroy the former, but both were to be offered,
as the extraordinary sacrifices of every feast did not hinder the
oblation of the daily sacrifice.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p11">19. One kid - In chap. iv, 14, the sin-offering for the
sin of the people is a bullock, but here a kid; &amp;c. the reason of
the difference may be this, because that was for some particular sin of
the people, but this only in general for all their sins.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p12">20. Wave them - Some part of them in the name of the
whole; and so for the two lambs, otherwise they had been too big and too
heavy, to be waved. For the priests - Who had to themselves not only the
breast and shoulder as in others, which belonged to the priest, but also
the rest which belonged to the offerer; because the whole congregation
being the offerer here, it could neither be distributed to them all, nor
given to some without offense to the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p13">21. An holy convocation - A sabbath or day of rest,
called pentecost; which was instituted, partly in remembrance of the
consummation of their deliverance out of Egypt by bringing them thence
to the mount of God, or Sinai, as God had promised, and of that
admirable blessing of giving the law to them on the 50th day, and
forming them into a commonwealth under his own immediate government; and
partly in gratitude for the farther progress of their harvest, as in the
passover they offered a thank-offering to God for the beginning of their
harvest. The perfection of this feast, was the pouring out of the Holy
Spirit upon the apostles on this very day, in which the law of faith was
given, fifty days after Christ our passover was sacrificed for us. And
on that day the apostles, having themselves received the first-fruits of
the spirit, begat three thousand souls thro' the word of truth, as the
first-fruits of the Christian church.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p14">22. When ye reap, thou - From the plural, ye, he comes to
the singular, thou, because he would press this duty upon every person
who hath an harvest to reap, that none might plead exemption from it.
And it is observable, that though the present business is only
concerning the worship of God, yet he makes a kind of excursion to
repeat a former law of providing for the poor, to shew that our devotion
to God is little esteemed by him if it be not accompanied with acts of
charity to men.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p15">24. A sabbath - Solemnized with the blowing of trumpets
by the priests, not in a common way, as they did every first day of
every month, but in an extraordinary manner, not only in Jerusalem, but
in all the cities of Israel. They began to blow at sun-rise, and
continued blowing till sun-set. This seems to have been instituted,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p16">1. To solemnize the beginning of the new
year, whereof as to civil matters and particularly as to the Jubilee,
this was the first day; concerning which it was fit the people should be
admonished, both to excite their thankfulness for God's blessings in the
last year, and to direct them in the management of their civil
affairs.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p17">2. To put a special honour upon this month.
For as the seventh day was the sabbath, and the seventh year was a
sabbatical year, so God would have the seventh month to be a kind of
sabbatical month, for the many sabbaths and solemn feasts which were
observed in this more than in any other month. And by this sounding of
the trumpets in its beginning, God would quicken and prepare them for
the following sabbaths, as well as that of atonement and humiliation for
their sins, as those of thanksgiving for God's mercies.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p18">27. Afflict your souls - With fasting, and bitter
repentance for all, especially their national sins, among which no doubt
God would have them remember their sin of the golden calf. For as God
had threatened to remember it in after times to punish them for it, so
there was great reason why they should remember it to humble themselves
for it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p19">28. Whatsoever soul - Either of the Jewish nation, or
religion. Hereby God would signify the absolute necessity which every
man had of repentance and forgiveness of sin, and the desperate
condition of all impenitent persons.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p20">32. From even to even - The day of atonement began at the
evening of the ninth day, and continued till the evening of the tenth
day. Ye shall celebrate your sabbath - This particular sabbath is called
your sabbath, possibly to note the difference between this and other
sabbaths: for the weekly sabbath is oft called the sabbath of the Lord.
The Jews are supposed to begin every day, and consequently their
sabbaths, at the evening, in remembrance of the creation, as Christians
generally begin their days and sabbaths with the morning in memory of
Christ's resurrection.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p21">34. Of tabernacles - Of tents or booths or arbours. This
feast was appointed to remind them of that time when they had no other
dwellings in the wilderness, and to stir them up to bless God, as well
for the gracious protection then afforded them, as for the more
commodious habitations now given them; and to excite them to gratitude
for all the fruits of the year newly ended, which were now compleatly
brought in.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p22">36. Ye shall offer - A several-offering each day. The
eighth day - Which though it was not one of the days of this feast
strictly taken. Yet in a larger sense it belonged to this feast, and is
called the great day of the feast, <scripRef passage="John vii. 37" id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p22.1" parsed="|John|7|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.7.37">John
vii, 37</scripRef>. And so indeed it was, as for other reasons, so because, by
their removal from the tabernacles into fixed habitations, it
represented that happy time wherein their 40 years tedious march in the
wilderness was ended with their settlement in the land of Canaan, which
it was most fit they should acknowledge with such a solemn day of
thanksgiving as this was.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p23">37. A sacrifice - A sin-offering, called by the general
name, a sacrifice, because it was designed for that which was the
principal end of all sacrifices, the expiation of sin.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p24">38. Beside the sabbaths - The offerings of the weekly
sabbaths. God will not have any sabbath-sacrifice diminished because of
the addition of others, proper to any other feast. And it is here to be
noted, that though other festival days are sometimes called sabbaths,
yet these are here called the sabbaths of the Lord, in way of
contradistinction, to shew that this was more eminently such than other
feast days. Your gifts - Which being here distinguished from the
free-will-offerings made to the Lord, may note what they freely gave to
the priests over and above their first-fruits and tithes or other
things which they were enjoined to give.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p25">39. This is no addition of a new, but only a repetition
of the former injunction, with a more particular explication both of the
manner and reason of the feast. The fruit - Not the corn, which was
gathered long before, but that of the trees, as vines, olives, and other
fruit-trees: which compleated the harvest, whence this is called the
feast of in-gathering.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p26">40. Of goodly trees - Namely, olive, myrtle and pine,
mentioned, <scripRef passage="Neh. viii. 15, 16" id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p26.1" parsed="|Neh|8|15|8|16" osisRef="Bible:Neh.8.15-Neh.8.16">Neh. viii, 15,
16</scripRef>, which were most plentiful there, and which would best
preserve their greenness. Thick trees - Fit for shade and shelter. And
willows - To mix with the other, and in some sort bind them together.
And as they made their booths of these materials, so they carried some
of these boughs in their hands, as is affirmed by Jewish and other
ancient writers.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p27">42. In booths - Which were erected in their cities or
towns, either in their streets, or gardens, or the tops of their houses.
These were made flat, and therefore were fit for the use.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxiv.ii-p28">44. The feasts of the Lord - We have reason to be
thankful, that the feasts of the Lord, now are not so numerous, nor the
observance of them so burdensome and costly; but more spiritual and
significant, and surer and sweeter earnests of the everlasting feast, at
the last in-gathering, which we hope to be celebrating to eternity.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="45.06%" prev="ii.iv.xxiv.ii" next="ii.iv.xxv.i" id="ii.iv.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XXIV" id="ii.iv.xxv-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xxv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIV" progress="45.07%" prev="ii.iv.xxv" next="ii.iv.xxv.ii" id="ii.iv.xxv.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.i-p1">Laws concerning the lamps, ver. 1-4. The shew-bread, ver.
5-9. Blasphemy occasioned by that of Shelomith's son, ver. 10-16. The
law of retaliation, ver. 17-22. The blasphemer stoned, ver. 23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIV" progress="45.07%" prev="ii.iv.xxv.i" next="ii.iv.xxvi" id="ii.iv.xxv.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p1">2. To cause the lamps to burn - Hebrew. the lamp: yet
ver. 4, it is the lamps: The seven lamps made all one lamp. In allusion
to which, the Blessed Spirit is represented, <scripRef passage="Rev. iv. 5" id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Rev|4|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.4.5">Rev. iv, 5</scripRef>, by seven lamps of fire before the throne. For there are
diversities of gifts, but one spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p2">3. Aaron - Either by himself, or by his sons, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxv. 37" id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Exod|25|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.25.37">Exod. xxv, 37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p3">4. The pure candlestick - So called, partly because it
was made of pure gold, partly because it was to be always kept
clean.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p4">5. Thou - By the priests or Levites, whose work it was to
prepare them, <scripRef passage="1Chr ix. 32" id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Chr|9|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.9.32">1Chr ix, 32</scripRef>. Twelve cakes - Representing the twelve tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p5">6. Two rows - Not one above another, but one beside
another, as the frankincense put upon each, ver. 7, shews.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p6">7. Pure frankincense - Unmixed and uncorrupted, or of the
best sort, to be burnt before the Lord. On the bread - And this was done
every time that the bread was changed. For a memorial - For that part
which properly belonged to God, whereas the rest belonged to the
priests.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p7">8. From the children of Israel - And these cakes are said
to be received from or offered by the children of Israel, bought with
the money which they contributed. By an everlasting covenant - By virtue
of that compact made between me and them, by which they were obliged to
keep this amongst other commands, and, they so doing, I am obliged to be
their God and to bless them. And this may be here called an everlasting
covenant, not only because it was to endure as long as the Jewish polity
stood, but also because this was to stand everlastingly, or continually,
and therefore the new cakes were first brought before the old were taken
away.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p8">9. It - The old bread now to be taken away. Made by fire
- The incense was offered by fire, and that for or instead of the bread,
and therefore the bread was reputed as if it had been so offered.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p9">10. Whose father was an Egyptian - This circumstance
seems noted, partly to shew the danger of marriages with persons of
wicked principles, and partly by this severity against him who was a
stranger by the father, and an Israelite by the mother, to shew that God
would not have this sin go unpunished amongst his people, what-soever he
was that committed it. Went out - Out of Egypt, being one of that mixed
multitude, which came out with the Israelites, <scripRef passage="Exod. xii. 32" id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Exod|12|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12.32">Exod. xii, 32</scripRef>. It is probable, this was done when the Israelites were near
Sinai.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p10">11. The name of the Lord - The words of the Lord, or of
Jehovah, are supplied out of ver. 16, where they are expressed; here
they are omitted perhaps for the aggravation of his crime. He blasphemed
the name so called by way of eminency; that name which is above every
name; that name which a man should in some sort tremble to mention;
which is not to be named without cause or without reverence. And cursed
- Not the Israelite only, but his God also, as appears from ver. 15, 16.
And they brought him - Either the people who heard him, or the inferior
magistrate, to whom he was first brought.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p11">12. That the mind of the Lord might be shewed - For God
had only said in general, that he would not hold such guiltless, that
is, he would punish them, but had not declared how he would have them
punished by men.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p12">14. Lay their hands upon his head - Whereby they gave
public testimony that they heard this person speak such words, and did
in their own and all the peoples names, demand justice to be executed
upon him, that by this sacrifice God might be appeased, and his
judgments turned away from the people, upon whom they would certainly
fall if he were unpunished. Stone him - The same punishment which was
before appointed for those who cursed their parents.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p13">15. Whosoever curseth his God - Speaketh of him
reproachfully. Shall bear his sin - That is, the punishment of it; shall
not go unpunished.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p14">16. He that blasphemeth the name of the Lord - This is a
repetition of the same sin in other words, which is common. As this law
is laid down in general terms, ver. 15, so both the sin and the
punishment are particularly expressed, ver. 16. All the congregation -
To shew their zeal for God, and to beget in them the greater dread and
abhorrence of blasphemy.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p15">17. He that killeth - This law is repeated here, to
prevent the mischievous effects of men's striving together, which as
here it caused blasphemy, so it might in others lead to murder.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p16">22. One law - That is, in matters of common right, but
not as to church privileges.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxv.ii-p17">23. Stone him with stones - This blasphemer was the first
that died by the law of Moses. Stephen the first that died for the
gospel, died by the abuse of the law. The martyr and the malefactor
suffered the same death; but how vast the difference between them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="45.15%" prev="ii.iv.xxv.ii" next="ii.iv.xxvi.i" id="ii.iv.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XXV" id="ii.iv.xxvi-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.25" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xxvi-p0.2">XXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXV" progress="45.15%" prev="ii.iv.xxvi" next="ii.iv.xxvi.ii" id="ii.iv.xxvi.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.i-p1">In token of his peculiar right to the land of Canaan, God
in this chapter appoints,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.xxvi.i-p2">1. That every seventh year should be a year
of rest, ver. 1-7.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.xxvi.i-p3">2. That every fiftieth year should be a
year of jubilee, ver. 8-17. A peculiar blessing annext, ver. 18-22. The
land sold may be redeemed: if not, it shall revert at the year of
jubilee, only with some exceptions, ver. 23-34. Usury forbidden, ver.
35-38. Jewish servants to be released at the jubilee, ver. 39. but
heathens might be retained, ver. 40-46. Of an Israelite that sold
himself to a stranger, ver. 47-55.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXV" progress="45.16%" prev="ii.iv.xxvi.i" next="ii.iv.xxvii" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p1">1. In Mount Sinai - That is, near Mount Sinai. So the
Hebrew particle beth is sometimes used. So there is no need to disturb
the history in this place.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p2">2. When ye come into the land - So as to be settled in
it; for the time of the wars was not to be accounted, nor the time
before Joshua's distribution of the land among them. Keep a sabbath -
That is, enjoy rest and freedom from plowing, and tilling. Unto the Lord
- In obedience and unto the honour of God. This was instituted,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p3">1. For the assertion of God's sovereign
right to the land, in which the Israelites were but tenants at God's
will.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p4">2. For the trial of their obedience.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p5">3. For the demonstration of his providence
as well in general towards men, as especially towards his own
people.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p6">4. To wean them from inordinate love, and
pursuit of worldly advantages, and to inure them to depend upon God
alone, and upon God's blessing for their subsistence.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p7">5. To put them in mind of that blessed and
eternal rest provided for all good men.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p8">4. A sabbath of rest to the land - They were neither to
do any work about it, nor expect any harvest from it. All yearly labours
were to be intermitted in the seventh year, as much as daily labours on
the seventh day.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p9">5. Of its own accord - From the grains that fell out of
the ears the last reaping time. Thou shalt not reap - That is, as thy
own peculiarly, but only so as others may reap it with thee, for present
food. Undressed - Not cut off by thee, but suffered to grow for the use
of the poor.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p10">6. The sabbath of the land - That is, the growth of the
sabbath, or that fruit which groweth in the sabbatical year. For thy
servant - For all promiscuously, to take food from thence as they need
it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p11">9. The jubilee - Signified the true liberty from our
spiritual debts and slaveries to be purchased by Christ, and to be
published to the world by the sound of the gospel. The seventh month -
Which was the first month of the year for civil affairs; the jubilee
therefore began in that month; and, as it seems, upon this very tenth
day, when the trumpet sounded, as other feasts generally began when the
trumpet sounded. In the day of atonement - A very fit time, that when
they fasted and prayed for God's mercy to them in the pardon of their
sins, then they might exercise their charity to men in forgiving their
debts; and to teach us, that the foundation of all solid comfort must be
laid in repentance and atonement for our sins through Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p12">10. The fiftieth year - The year of jubilee was not the
forty and ninth year, as some learned men think, but precisely the
fiftieth. The old weekly sabbath is called the seventh day, because it
truly was so, being next after the six days of the week and distinct
from them all: and the year of release is called the seventh year, ver.
4, as immediately following the six years, ver. 3, and distinct from
them all. And in like manner the jubilee is called the fiftieth year,
because it comes next after seven tines seven or forty-nine years, ver.
8, and is distinct from them all. Unto all the inhabitants - Understand
such as were Israelites; principally to all servants, even to such as
would not and did not go out at the seventh year, and to the poor, who
now were acquitted from all their debts, and restored to their
possessions. Jubilee - So called either from the Hebrew word Jobel which
signifies first a ram, and then a ram's horn, by the sound whereof it
was proclaimed; or from Jubal the inventor of musical instruments, <scripRef passage="Gen. iv. 21" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Gen|4|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.4.21">Gen. iv, 21</scripRef>, because it was celebrated with music and all expressions of
joy. Unto his possession - Which had been sold or otherwise alienated
from him. This law was not at all unjust, because all buyers and sellers
had an eye to this condition in their bargains; but it was expedient in
many regards, as</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p13">1. To mind them that God alone was the Lord
and proprietor both of them and of their lands, and they only his
tenants; a point which they were very apt to forget.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p14">2. That hereby inheritances, families, and
tribes, might be kept entire and clear until the coming of the Messiah,
who was to be known as by other things, so by the tribe and family out
of which he was to come. And this accordingly was done by the singular
providence of God until the Lord Jesus did come. Since which time those
characters are miserably confounded: which is no small argument that the
Messiah is come.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p15">3. To set bounds both to the insatiable
avarice of some, and the foolish prodigality of others, that the former
might not wholly and finally swallow up the inheritances of their
brethren, and the latter might not be able to undo themselves and their
posterity forever, which was a singular privilege of this law and
people. His family - From whom he was gone, being sold to some other
family either by himself or by his father.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p16">12. It shall be holy - So it was, because it was
sequestered in great part from worldly employments and dedicated to God,
and to the exercise of holy joy and thankfulness; and because it was a
type of that holy and happy jubilee which they were to expect and enjoy
under the Messiah. The increase thereof - Such things as it produced of
itself. Out of the field - Whence they in common with others might take
it as they needed it; but must not put it into barns, See ver. 5, and <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiii. 11" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Exod|23|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.23.11">Exod. xxiii, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p17">14. Ye shall not oppress - Neither the seller by
requiring more, nor the buyer by taking the advantage from his brother's
necessities to give him less than the worth of it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p18">15. Years of fruits - Or, fruitful years; for there were
some unfruitful years; those wherein they were not allowed to sow or
reap.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p19">16. Years of fruits - Or, For the number of the fruits.
The meaning is, he selleth not the land, but only the fruits thereof,
and that for a certain time.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p20">21. For three years - Not compleatly, but in great part,
namely, for that part of the 6th year which was between the beginning of
harvest and the beginning of the 7th year, for the whole 7th year, and
for that part of the 8th year which was before the harvest, which
reached almost until the beginning of the ninth year. This is added to
shew the equity of this command. As God would hereby try their faith and
obedience, so he gave them an eminent proof of his own exact providence
and tender care over them in making provisions suitable to their
necessities.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p21">22. Old fruit - Of the sixth year principally, if not
solely.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p22">23. For ever - So as to be forever alienated from the
family of him that sells it. Or, absolutely and properly, so as to
become the property of the buyer: Or, to the extermination or utter
cutting off, namely, of the seller, from all hopes and possibility of
redemption. The land is mine - Procured for you by my power, given to
you by my grace and bounty, and the right of propriety reserved by me.
With me - That is, in my land or houses: thus he is said to sojourn with
another that dwells in his house. Howsoever in your own or other mens
opinions you pass for lords and proprietors, yet in truth, ye are but
strangers and sojourners, not to possess the land forever, but only for
a season, and to leave it to such as I have appointed for it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p23">24. A redemption - A right of redemption in the time and
manner following.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p24">25. If any of his kin come - Or, If the redeemer come,
being near akin to him, who in this was an eminent type of Christ, who
was made near akin to us by taking our flesh, that he might perform the
work of redemption for us.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p25">27. The years of the sale - That is, from the time of the
sale to the jubilee. See above, ver. 15, 16. The overplus - That is, a
convenient price for the years from this redemption to the jubilee.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p26">28. Go out - That is, out of the buyer's hand, without
any redemption money.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p27">30. It shall not go out - The reasons before alledged for
lands do not hold in such houses; there was no danger of confusion in
tribes or families by the alienation of houses. The seller also had a
greater propriety in houses than in lands, as being commonly built by
the owner's cost and diligence, and therefore had a fuller power to
dispose of them. Besides, God would hereby encourage persons to buy and
possess houses in such places, as frequency and fulness of inhabitants
in cities, was a great strength, honour and advantage to the whole
land.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p28">31. In the villages - Because they belonged to and were
necessary for the management of the lands.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p29">34. May not be sold - Not sold at all, partly, because it
was of absolute necessity for them for the keeping of their cattle, and
partly because these were no enclosures, but common fields, in which all
the Levites that lived in such a city had an interest, and therefore no
particular Levite could dispose of his part in it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p30">35. A sojourner - Understand it of proselytes only, for
of other strangers they were permitted to take usury, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxiii. 20" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p30.1" parsed="|Deut|23|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.23.20">Deut. xxiii, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p31">36. Of him - That is, of thy brother, whether he be
Israelite, or proselyte. Or increase - All kinds of usury are in this
case forbidden, whether of money, or of victuals, or of any thing that
is commonly lent by one man to another upon usury, or upon condition of
receiving the thing lent with advantage and overplus. If one borrow in
his necessity, there can be no doubt but this law is binding still. But
it cannot be thought to bind, where money is borrowed for purchase of
lands, trade, or other improvements. For there it is reasonable, that
the lender share with the borrower in the profit.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p32">39. As a bond-man - Neither for the time, forever, nor
for the manner, with the hardest and vilest kinds of service, rigorously
and severely exacted.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p33">41. Then shall he depart - Thou shalt not suffer him or
his to abide longer in thy service, as thou mightest do in the year of
release, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxi. 2, 6" id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p33.1" parsed="|Exod|21|2|0|0;|Exod|21|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.21.2 Bible:Exod.21.6">Exod. xxi, 2,
6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p34">42. They are my servants - They, no less than you, are
members of my church and people; such as I have chosen out of all the
world to serve me here, and to enjoy me hereafter, and therefore are not
to be oppressed, neither are you absolute lords over them to deal with
them as you please.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p35">43. Fear thy God - Though thou dost not fear them who are
in thy power, and unable to right themselves, yet fear that God who hath
commanded thee to use them kindly, and who can and will avenge their
cause, if thou oppress them.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p36">47. The flock - Hebrew. root, that is, one of the root or
flock. So the word root is elsewhere used for the branch or progeny
growing from it. He seems to note one of a foreign race and country,
transplanted into the land of Israel, and there having taken root
amongst the people of God, yet even such an one, though he hath some
privilege by it, shall not have power to keep an Hebrew servant from the
benefit of redemption.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p37">50. According to the time of an hired servant - Allowance
shall be made for the time wherein he hath served, proportionable to
that which is given to an hired servant for so long service, because his
condition is in this like theirs; it is not properly his person, but his
work and labour that was sold.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvi.ii-p38">53. In thy sight - Thou shalt not suffer this to be done,
but whethe thou art a magistrate, or a private person, thou shalt take
care according to thy capacity to get it remedied.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="45.36%" prev="ii.iv.xxvi.ii" next="ii.iv.xxvii.i" id="ii.iv.xxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XXVI" id="ii.iv.xxvii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.26" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xxvii-p0.2">XXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVI" progress="45.36%" prev="ii.iv.xxvii" next="ii.iv.xxvii.ii" id="ii.iv.xxvii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.i-p1">A general enforcement of the preceding laws, by promises
of reward, and threats of punishment: Wherein is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.xxvii.i-p2">I. A repetition of some principal
commandments, ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.xxvii.i-p3">II. A promise of all good to the obedient,
ver. 3-13.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.xxvii.i-p4">III. A threatening of terrible judgments to
the disobedient, ver. 14- 39.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.iv.xxvii.i-p5">IV. A promise of mercy to the penitent,
ver. 40-46.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVI" progress="45.36%" prev="ii.iv.xxvii.i" next="ii.iv.xxviii" id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p1">1. An image - Or pillar, that is, to worship it, or bow
down to it, as it follows. Otherwise this was not simply prohibited,
being practiced by holy men, both before and after this law.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p2">2. My sanctuary - By purging and preserving it from all
uncleanness, by approaching to it and managing all the services of it
with reverence, and in such manner only as God hath appointed.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p3">4. Rain - Therefore God placed them not in a land where
there were such rivers as the Nile, to water it and make it fruitful,
but in a land which depended wholly upon the rain of heaven, the key
whereof God kept in his own hand, that so he might the more effectually
oblige them to obedience, in which their happiness consisted.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p4">5. The vintage - That is, you shall have so plentiful an
harvest, that you shall not be able to thresh out your corn in a little
time, but that work will last till the vintage.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p5">6. The sword - That is, war, as the sword is oft taken.
It shall not enter into it, nor have passage through it, much less shall
your land be made the seat of war.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p6">8. Five - A small number; a certain number for an
uncertain.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p7">9. Establish my covenant - That is, actually perform all
that I have promised in my covenant made with you.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p8">10. Bring forth - Or, cast out, throw them away as having
no occasion to spend them, or give them to the poor, or even to your
cattle, that you may make way for the new corn, which also is so
plentiful, that of itself it will fill up your barns.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p9">11. I will set - As I have placed it, so I will continue
it among you, and not remove it from you, as once I did upon your
miscarriage, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxiii. 7" id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Exod|33|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.33.7">Exod. xxxiii,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p10">12. I will walk among you - As I have hitherto done, both
by my pillar of cloud and fire, and by my tabernacle, which have walked
or gone along with you in all your journeys, and staid among you in all
your stations, to protect, conduct, instruct, and comfort you. And I
will own you for that peculiar people which I have singled out of
mankind, to bless you here and to save you hereafter.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p11">13. Upright - With heads lifted up, not pressed down with
a yoke. It notes their liberty, security, confidence and glory.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p12">15. Break my covenant - Break your part of that covenant
made between me and you, and thereby discharge me from the blessings
promised on my part.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p13">16. That shall consume the eyes, and cause sorrow of
heart - Two remarkable effects of this distemper, when it continues
long. It eminently weakens the sight, and sinks the spirit. All
chronical diseases are here included in the consumption, all acute in
the burning ague or fever. 19. The pride of your power - That is, your
strength of which you are proud, your numerous and united forces, your
kingdom, yea, your ark and sanctuary. I will make your heaven as iron -
The heavens shall yield you no rain, nor the earth fruits.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p14">20. In vain - in plowing, and sowing, and tilling the
ground.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p15">25. The quarrel of my covenant - That is, my quarrel with
you for your breach of your covenant made with me.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p16">26. When I have broken the staff of your bread - By
sending a famine or scarcity of bread, which is the staff and support of
man's present life. Ten women - That is, ten or many families, for the
women took care for the bread and food of all the family. By weight -
This is a sign and consequence both of a famine, and of the baking of
the bread of several families together in one oven, wherein each family
took care to weigh their bread, and to receive the same proportion which
they put in.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p17">29. The flesh of your sons - Through extreme hunger. See <scripRef passage="Lam. iv. 10" id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Lam|4|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lam.4.10">Lam. iv, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p18">30. High places - In which you will sacrifice after the
manner of the Heathens. The carcases of your idols - So he calls them,
either to signify that their idols how specious soever or glorious in
their eyes, were in truth but lifeless and contemptible carcases; or to
shew that their idols should be so far from helping them, that they
should be thrown down and broken with them, and both should lie together
in a forlorn and loathsome state.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p19">31. Sanctuaries - God's sanctuary, called sanctuaries
here, as also <scripRef passage="Psalm 7" id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Ps|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.7">Psalm 7</scripRef>iii, 17; 7iv, 7 <scripRef passage="Jer. li. 51" id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p19.2" parsed="|Jer|51|51|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.51.51">Jer. li, 51</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Ezek. xxviii. 18" id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p19.3" parsed="|Ezek|28|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.28.18">Ezek. xxviii, 18</scripRef>, because there were divers apartments in it, each of which
was a sanctuary, or, which is all one, an holy place, as they are
severally called. And yours emphatically, not mine, for I disown and
abhor it, and all the services you do in it, because you have defiled
it. I will not smell - Not own or accept them. Your sweet odours -
Either of the incense, or of your sacrifices, which when offered with
faith and obedience, are sweet and acceptable to me.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p20">32. Who dwell therein - Having driven you out and
possessed your places.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p21">33. After you - The sword shall follow you into strange
lands, and you shall have no rest there.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p22">34. The land shall enjoy her sabbaths - It shall enjoy
those sabbatical years of rest from tillage, which you through
covetousness would not give it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p23">37. When none pursueth - Your guilt and fear causing you
to imagine that they do pursue when indeed they do not.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p24">39. Pine away - Be consumed and melt away by degrees
through diseases, oppressions, griefs, and manifold miseries.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p25">40. If they shall confess their iniquity, and the
iniquity of their fathers, with their trespass which they have
trespassed against me - That is, with their prevarication with me and
defection from me to idolatry, which by way of eminency he calls their
trespass: and that also they have walked contrary to me, ver. 41, and
that I also have walked contrary unto them, and have brought them into
the land of their enemies - That is, that they are not come into these
calamities by chance, nor by the misfortune of war, but by my just
judgment upon them. And, if then their uncircumcised, that is, impure,
carnal, profane, and impenitent hearts be humbled, that is, subdued,
purged, reformed: if to this confession they add sincere humiliation and
reformation, I will do what follows.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p26">41. If they accept of - The meaning is, if they sincerely
acknowledge the righteousness of God and their own wickedness, and
patiently submit to his correcting hand; if with David they are ready to
say, it is good for them that they are afflicted, that they may learn
God's statutes, and yield obedience to them for the future, which is a
good evidence of true repentance.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p27">42. I will remember my covenant - So as to make good all
that I have promised in it. For words of knowledge or remembrance in
scripture, commonly denote affection and kindness. I will remember the
land - Which now seems to be forgotten and despised, as if I had never
chosen it to be the peculiar place of my presence and blessing.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p28">44. For I am the Lord their God - Therefore neither the
desperateness of their condition, nor the greatness of their sins, shall
make me wholly make void my covenant with them and their ancestors, but
I will in due time remember them for good, and for my covenant's sake
return to them in mercy. From this place the Jews take great comfort,
and assure themselves of deliverance out of their present servitude and
misery. And from this, and such other places, St. Paul concludes, that
the Israelitish nation, tho' then rejected and ruined, should be
gathered again and restored.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxvii.ii-p29">46. These are the laws which the Lord made between him
and the children of Israel - Hereby his communion with his church is
kept up. He manifests not only his dominion over them, but his favour to
them, by giving them his law. And they manifest not only their holy
fear, but their holy love by the observance of it. And thus it is made
between them rather as a covenant than as a law: for he draws them with
the cords of a man.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="45.50%" prev="ii.iv.xxvii.ii" next="ii.iv.xxviii.i" id="ii.iv.xxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Lev. XXVII" id="ii.iv.xxviii-p0.1" parsed="|Lev|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.27" /> 
<h3 id="ii.iv.xxviii-p0.2">XXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVII" progress="45.50%" prev="ii.iv.xxviii" next="ii.iv.xxviii.ii" id="ii.iv.xxviii.i">

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.i-p1">Laws concerning persons sanctified to God, ver. 1-8.
Concerning cattle, ver. 9-13. Concerning houses and lands, ver. 14-25.
An exception concerning firstlings, ver. 26-27. Concerning what was
devoted, ver. 28, 29. Concerning tithes, ver. 30-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVII" progress="45.50%" prev="ii.iv.xxviii.i" next="ii.v" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p1">2. A singular vow-Or, an eminent, or hard vow, not
concerning things, which was customary, but concerning persons, which he
devoted to the Lord, which was unusual and difficult: yet there want not
instances of persons who devoted either themselves or their children,
and that either more strictly, as the Nazarites, and the Levites, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. i. 11" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|1Sam|1|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.1.11">1 Sam. i, 11</scripRef>, and for these there was no redemption admitted, but they
were in person to perform the service to which they were devoted: or
more largely, as some who were not Levites, might yet through zeal to
God, or to obtain God's help, which they wanted or desired, devote
themselves or their children to the service of God and of the sanctuary,
tho' not in such a way as the Levites, which was forbidden, yet in some
kind of subserviency to them. And because there might be too great a
number of persons thus dedicated, which might be burdensome to the
sanctuary, an exchange is allowed, and the priests are directed to
receive a tax for their redemption. By thy estimation - Thine, O man
that vowest, as appears from ver. 8, where his estimation is opposed to
the priest's valuation. Nor was there any fear of his partiality in his
own cause, for the price is particularly limited. But where the price is
undetermined, there, to avoid that inconvenience, the priest is to value
it, as ver. 8, 12.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p2">3. Unto sixty years - Which is the best time for strength
and service, and therefore prized at the highest rate.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p3">4. Thirty shekels - Less than the man's price, because
she is inferior to him both in strength and serviceableness.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p4">5. Five years old - At which age they might be vowed by
their parents, as appears from <scripRef passage="1 Sam. i. 11-28" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Sam|1|11|1|28" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.1.11-1Sam.1.28">1
Sam. i, 11-28</scripRef>, tho' not by themselves; and the children were obliged by
their parents vow, which is not strange considering the parents right to
dispose of their children so far as is not contrary to the mind of
God.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p5">8. Than thy estimation - If he be not able to pay the
price which thou, according to the rules here given, requirest of
him.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p6">9. Whereof men bring an offering - That is, a clean
beast. Giveth - Voweth to give: Shall be holy - Consecrated to God,
either to be sacrificed, or to be given to the priest, according to the
manner of the vow, and the intention of him that voweth.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p7">10. He shall not alter it, nor change it - Two words
expressing the same thing more emphatically, that is, he shall in no
wise change it, neither for one of the same, nor of another kind: partly
because God would preserve the reverence of consecrated things, and
therefore would not have them alienated, and partly to prevent abuses of
them who on this pretense might exchange it for the worse. It and the
exchange - That is, both the thing first vowed, and the thing offered or
given in exchange. This was inflicted upon him as a just penalty for his
levity in such weighty matters.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p8">11. Unclean - Either for the kind, or for the quality of
it; if it were such an one as might not be offered.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p9">14. Sanctify his house - By a vow, for of that way and
manner of sanctification he speaks in this whole chapter.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p10">15. The fifth part - Which he might the better do,
because the priests did usually put a moderate rate upon it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p11">16. Of his possession - That is, which is his by
inheritance, because particular direction is given about purchased
lands, ver. 22. And he saith, part of it, for it was unlawful to vow
away all his possessions, because thereby he disabled himself from the
performance of divers duties, and made himself burdensome to his
brethren. According to the seed - That is, according to the quantity and
quality of the land, which is known by the quantity of seed which it can
receive and return. Fifty-shekels - Not to be paid yearly, 'till the
year of jubilee, but once for all, as is most probable,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p12">1. Because here is no mention of any yearly
payment, but only of one payment.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p13">2. Because it is probable that lands were
moderately valued, that men might be rather encouraged to make such
vows, than deterred by excessive impositions. But if this were yearly
rent, it was an excessive rate, and much more than the land ordinarily
yielded. For an omer is but the tenth part of an ephah, about a pottle
of our measure, which quantity of seed would not extend very far, and in
some lands would yield but an inconsiderable crop, especially in barley,
which was cheaper than wheat and which for that reason, among others,
may be mentioned rather than wheat.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p14">17. From the year of jubilee - That is, immediately after
the year of jubilee is past. According to thy estimation - Now
mentioned, of fifty shekels for an omer of barley seed. It shall stand -
That is, that price shall be paid without diminution.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p15">18. After the jubilee - That is, some considerable time
after. The defalcation from the full price of fifty shekels shall be
more or less as the years are more or fewer.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p16">20. If he will not redeem it - When the priest shall set
a price upon it, and offer it to him in the first place to redeem it:
or, rather and, for this seems to be added by way of accumulation, if
he, that is, the priest, of whom he might have redeemed it, upon his
refusal, offers it to sale, and have sold the field to another man - He
shall forever lose the benefit of redemption.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p17">21. When it goeth out - That is, out of the possession of
the other man to whom the priest sold it. The possession shall be the
priests - For their maintenance. Nor is this repugnant to that law, that
the priests should have no inheritance in the land, <scripRef passage="Num. xviii. 20" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Num|18|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.18.20">Num. xviii, 20</scripRef>, for that is only spoken of, the tribe of Levi in general,
in reference to the first division of the land, wherein the Levites were
not to have a distinct part of land, as other tribes had; but this doth
not hinder, but some particular lands might be vowed and given to the
priests, either for their own benefit, or for the service of the
sanctuary.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p18">22. His possession - His patrimony or inheritance.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p19">23. Thy estimation - That is, the price which thou, O
Moses, by my direction hast set in such cases. To the jubilee - As much
as it is worth, for that space of time between the making of the vow and
the year of jubilee: for he had no right to it for any longer time, as
the next verse tells us. As an holy thing - As that which is to be
consecrated to God instead of the land redeemed by it.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p20">25. The shekel - About 2s. 6d.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p21">26. No man shall sanctify it - By vow; because it is not
his own, but the Lord's already, and therefore to vow such a thing to
God is a tacit derogation from, and an usurpation of the Lord's right,
and a mocking of God by pretending to give what we cannot withhold from
him. Or ox or sheep - Under these two eminent kinds he comprehends all
other beasts which might be sacrificed to God, the firstlings whereof
could not be redeemed but were to be sacrificed; whereas the firstlings
of men were to be redeemed, and therefore were capable of being vowed,
as we see, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. i. 11" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p21.1" parsed="|1Sam|1|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.1.11">1 Sam. i, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p22">27. An unclean beast - That is, if it be the first-born
of an unclean beast, as appears from ver. 26, which could not be vowed,
because it was a first-born, nor offered, because it was unclean, and
therefore is here commanded to be redeemed or sold. It shall be sold -
And the price thereof was given to the priests, or brought into the
Lord's treasury.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p23">28. No devoted thing - That is, nothing which is
absolutely devoted to God with a curse upon themselves or others, if
they disposed not of it according to their vow; as the Hebrew word
implies. Most holy - That is, only to be touched or employed by the
priests, and by no other persons; no not by their own families, for that
was the state of the most holy things.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24">29. Devoted of men - Not by men, as some would elude It;
but of men, for it is manifest both from this and the foregoing verses,
that men are here not the persons devoting, but devoted to destruction,
either by God's sentence, as idolaters, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxii. 20" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.1" parsed="|Exod|22|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.22.20">Exod. xxii, 20</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Deut. xxiii. 15" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.2" parsed="|Deut|23|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.23.15">Deut. xxiii, 15</scripRef>, the Canaanites, <scripRef passage="Deut. xx. 17" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.3" parsed="|Deut|20|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.20.17">Deut. xx, 17</scripRef>, the Amalekites, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 19" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.4" parsed="|Deut|25|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.19">Deut. xxv,
19</scripRef>, and <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xv. 3, 26" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.5" parsed="|1Sam|15|3|0|0;|1Sam|15|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.15.3 Bible:1Sam.15.26">1 Sam. xv, 3,
26</scripRef>, Benhaded, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xx. 42" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.6" parsed="|1Kgs|20|42|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.20.42">1 Kings xx,
42</scripRef>, or by men, in pursuance of such a sentence of God, as <scripRef passage="Num. xxi. 2, 3" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.7" parsed="|Num|21|2|21|3" osisRef="Bible:Num.21.2-Num.21.3">Num. xxi, 2, 3</scripRef>; xxxi, 17, or for any crime of an high nature, as <scripRef passage="Jude xxi. 5" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.8" parsed="|Jude|21|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.21.5">Jude xxi, 5</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Josh. xvii. 15" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.9" parsed="|Josh|17|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.17.15">Josh. xvii, 15</scripRef>. But this is not to be generally understood, as some have
taken it, as if a Jew might by virtue of this Text, devote his child or
his servant to the Lord, and thereby oblige himself to put them to
death. For this is expressly limited to all that a man hath, or which is
his, that is, which he hath a power over. But the Jews had no power over
the lives of their children or servants, but were directly forbidden to
take them away, by that great command, thou shalt do no murder. And
seeing he that killed his servant casually by a blow with a rod was
surely to be punished, as is said, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxi. 20" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p24.10" parsed="|Exod|21|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.21.20">Exod. xxi, 20</scripRef>, it could not be lawful wilfully to take away his life upon
pretense of any such vow as this. But for the Canaanites, Amalekites,
&amp;c. God the undoubted Lord of all men's lives, gave to the
Israelites a power over their persons and lives, and a command to put
them to death. And this verse may have a special respect to them or such
as them.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p25">30. The tithe - There are divers sorts of tithes, but
this seems to be understood only of the ordinary and yearly tithes
belonging to the Levites, as the very expression intimates, and the
addition of the fifth part in case of redemption thereof implies.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p26">32. Under the rod - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p27">1. The tither's rod, it being the manner of
the Jews in tithing to cause all their cattle to pass through some gate
or narrow passage, where the tenth was marked by a person appointed for
that purpose and reserved for the priest. Or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p28">2. the shepherd's rod, under which the
herds and flocks passed, and by which they were governed and numbered.
See <scripRef passage="Jer. xxxiii. 13" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p28.1" parsed="|Jer|33|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.33.13">Jer. xxxiii, 13</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Ezek. xx. 37" id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p28.2" parsed="|Ezek|20|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.20.37">Ezek.
xx, 37</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.iv.xxviii.ii-p29">34. These are the commandments which the Lord commanded
Moses for the children of Israel in M/ount Sinai - This has reference to
the whole book. Many of these commandments are moral: others ceremonial
and peculiar to the Jewish economy: Which yet are instructive to us, who
have a key to the mysteries that are contained in them. Upon the whole,
we have cause to bless God, that we are not come to Mount Sinai, that we
are not under the dark shadows of the law, but enjoy the clear light of
the gospel. The doctrine of our reconciliation to God by a Mediator, is
not clouded with the smoke of burning sacrifices, but cleared by the
knowledge of Christ, and him crucified. And we may praise him, that we
are not under the yoke of the law, but under the sweet and easy
instructions of the gospel, which pronounces those the true worshippers,
that worship the Father in spirit and in truth, by Christ only, who is
our priest, temple, altar, sacrifice, purification and all.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE FOURTH BOOK OF MOSES CALLED NUMBERS" progress="45.69%" prev="ii.iv.xxviii.ii" next="ii.v.i" id="ii.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num" id="ii.v-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.v-p0.2">NOTES ON THE FOURTH BOOK OF MOSES CALLED NUMBERS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Numbers" progress="45.69%" prev="ii.v" next="ii.v.ii" id="ii.v.i">

<p id="ii.v.i-p1">THIS book is thus entitled, because of the numbers of the
children of Israel, so often mentioned therein, an eminent
accomplishment of God's promise to Abraham, that his seed should be as
the stars of heaven for multitude. It also relates two numberings of
them, one at Mount Sinai, chap. 1. the other, thirty-nine years after.
And there are not three men of the same in the last account that were in
the first. The book is almost equally divided, between histories and
laws intermixed. An abstract of much of this book we have in a few
words, <scripRef passage="Psalm xcv. 10" id="ii.v.i-p1.1" parsed="|Ps|95|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.95.10">Psalm xcv, 10</scripRef>. Forty years long was I grieved with this generation: and an
application of it to ourselves, <scripRef passage="Heb. iv. 1" id="ii.v.i-p1.2" parsed="|Heb|4|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.4.1">Heb. iv, 1</scripRef>. Let us fear lest we come short!</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="45.71%" prev="ii.v.i" next="ii.v.ii.i" id="ii.v.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. I" id="ii.v.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="45.71%" prev="ii.v.ii" next="ii.v.ii.ii" id="ii.v.ii.i">

<p id="ii.v.ii.i-p1">Orders given to Moses to number the people, ver. 1-4.
Persons named to assist him therein, ver. 5-16. The particular number of
each tribe, ver. 17-43. The sum of all together, ver. 44-46. The Levites
excepted, ver. 47-54.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter I" progress="45.71%" prev="ii.v.ii.i" next="ii.v.iii" id="ii.v.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p1">1. In the wilderness - Where now they had been a full
year or near it, as may be gathered by comparing this place with <scripRef passage="Exod. xix. 1" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|19|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.19.1">Exod. xix, 1</scripRef>; xl, 17.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p2">2. Take the sum - This is not the same muster with that <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxviii. 26" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Exod|38|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.38.26">Exod. xxxviii, 26</scripRef>, as plainly appears, because that was before the building of
the tabernacle, which was built and set up on the first day of the first
month, <scripRef passage="Exod. xl. 2" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Exod|40|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.40.2">Exod. xl, 2</scripRef>, but this was after it, on the first day of the second
month. And they were for different ends; that was to tax them for the
charges of the tabernacle; but this was for other ends, partly that the
great number of the people might be known to the praise of God's
faithfulness, in making good his promises of multiplying them, and to
their own encouragement: partly for the better ordering their camp and
march, for they were now beginning their journey; and partly that this
account might he compared with the other in the close of the book, where
we read that not one of all this vast number, except Caleb and Joshua
were left alive; a fair warning to all future generations to take heed
of rebelling against the Lord. It is true, the sums and numbers agree in
this and that computation, which is not strange, because there was not
much time between the two numberings, and no eminent sin among the
people in that interval, whereby God was provoked to diminish their
numbers. Some conceive that in that number, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxx. 11-16; xxxviii. 25, 26" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p2.3" parsed="|Exod|30|11|30|16;|Exod|38|25|38|26" osisRef="Bible:Exod.30.11-Exod.30.16 Bible:Exod.38.25-Exod.38.26">Exod. xxx, 11-16 and xxxviii, 25, 26</scripRef>, the Levites were included, which are here excepted, ver.
47, and that in that interval of time, there were grown up as many more
men of those years as there were Levites of the same age. Israel - So
the strangers mixed with them, were not numbered. Their fathers - The
people were divided into twelve tribes, the tribes into great families,
ver. xxvi, 5, these great families into lesser families called the
houses of their fathers, because they were distinguished one from
another by their fathers.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p3">5. Reuben - The tribes are here numbered according to the
order or quality of their birth, first the children of Leah, then of
Rachel, and then of the handmaids.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p4">12. Deuel - Called Reuel, chap. iii, 14, the Hebrew
letters Daleth and Resh being often changed.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p5">19. He numbered them - For ought that appears in one
day.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p6">20. By their generations - That is, the persons begotten
of Reuben's immediate children, who are here subdivided into families,
and they into houses, and they into particular persons.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p7">27. Threescore and fourteen thousand - Far more than any
other tribe, in accomplishing Jacob's prophecy, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 8-12" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Gen|49|8|49|12" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.8-Gen.49.12">Gen. xlix, 8-12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p8">33. Ephraim - Above 8000 more than Manasseh, towards the
accomplishment of that promise, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlviii. 20" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Gen|48|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.48.20">Gen. xlviii, 20</scripRef>, which the devil in vain attempted to defeat by stirring up
the men of Gath against them, <scripRef passage="1Chr vii. 21, 22" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p8.2" parsed="|1Chr|7|21|7|22" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.7.21-1Chr.7.22">1Chr vii, 21, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p9">37. Thirty five thousand - The smallest number, except
one, though Benjamin had more immediate children than any of his
brethren, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlvi. 21" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Gen|46|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.46.21">Gen. xlvi, 21</scripRef>, whereas Daniel had but one immediate son, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlvi. 23" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p9.2" parsed="|Gen|46|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.46.23">Gen. xlvi, 23</scripRef>, yet now his number is the biggest but one of all the
tribes, and is almost double to that of Benjamin. Such great and strange
changes God easily can, and frequently doth make in families, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. ii. 5" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p9.3" parsed="|1Sam|2|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.2.5">1 Sam. ii, 5</scripRef>. And therefore let none boast or please themselves too much
in their numerous offspring.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p10">49. Levi - Because they were not generally to go out to
war, which was the thing principally eyed in this muster, ver. 3, 20,
45, but were to attend upon the service of the tabernacle. They that
minister upon holy things, should not entangle themselves in secular
affairs. The ministry itself is work enough for a whole man, and all
little enough to be employed in it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p11">50. The tabernacle of testimony - So called here, and <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxviii. 21" id="ii.v.ii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Exod|38|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.38.21">Exod. xxxviii, 21</scripRef>, because it was made chiefly for the sake of the ark of the
testimony, which is often called the testimony.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p12">51. That cometh nigh - The stranger elsewhere is one of
another nation, here one of another tribe. So as to do the offices
mentioned, ver. 50.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ii.ii-p13">53. No wrath - From God, who is very tender of his
worship, and will not suffer the profaners of it go unpunished! whose
wrath is called simply wrath by way of eminency, as the most terrible
kind of wrath.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="45.78%" prev="ii.v.ii.ii" next="ii.v.iii.i" id="ii.v.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. II" id="ii.v.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="45.78%" prev="ii.v.iii" next="ii.v.iii.ii" id="ii.v.iii.i">

<p id="ii.v.iii.i-p1">Orders concerning the camp,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.iii.i-p2">1. A general order, ver. 1, 2.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.iii.i-p3">2. Particular directions for posting each
of the tribes, in four squadrons. In the vanguard, on the east, Judah,
Issachar, and Zebulun, ver. 3-9. In the right wing, southward, Reuben,
Simeon, and Gad, ver. 10-16. The tabernacle in the midst, ver. 17. In
the rear, westward, Ephraim, Manasseh, and Benjamin, ver. 18-24. In the
left wing, northward, Daniel, Asher, and Naphtali, ver. 25-31. The
conclusion of the appointment, ver. 32-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter II" progress="45.79%" prev="ii.v.iii.i" next="ii.v.iv" id="ii.v.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.iii.ii-p1">2. His own standard - It is manifest there were four
great standards or ensigns, which here follow, distinguished by their
colours or figures; also there were other particular ensigns belonging
to each of their fathers houses or families. Far off - Partly out of
reverence to God and his worship, and the portion, allotted to it, and
partly for caution, lest their vicinity to it might tempt them to make
too near approaches to it. It is supposed they Were at 2000 cubits
distance from it, which was the space between the people and the ark;
and it is not improbable, because the Levites encamped round about it,
between them and the tabernacle. It is observable, those tribes were
placed together, that were nearest of kin to each other. Judah,
Issachar, and Zebulun were the three youngest sons of Leah, and Issachar
and Zebulun would not grudge to be under Judah, their elder brother.
Reuben and Simeon would not be content with their place. Therefore
Reuben, Jacob's eldest son, is chief of the next squadron. Simeon
doubtless is willing to be under him. And Gad, the son of Leah's
handmaid, is fitly added to him, in Levi's room. Ephraim Manasseh, and
Benjamin are all the posterity of Rachel. Daniel the eldest son of
Bilhah leads the rest; to them are added the two younger sons of the
handmaids. So much of the wisdom of God appears even in these smaller
circumstances!</p>

<p id="ii.v.iii.ii-p2">3. Judah - This tribe was in the first post, and in their
marches led the van, not only because it was the most numerous, but
chiefly because Christ, the Lion of the tribe of Judah, was to descend
from it: Yea, from the loins of Nahshon, who is here appointed the chief
captain of it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iii.ii-p3">17. In the midst - This is not to be understood strictly,
but largely; for in their march they were divided, and part of that
tribe marched next after Judah, chap. x, 17, and the other part exactly
in the midst of the camp.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iii.ii-p4">18. Ephraim - Who is here preferred before his brother,
according to the prophecy, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlviii. 19, 20" id="ii.v.iii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Gen|48|19|48|20" osisRef="Bible:Gen.48.19-Gen.48.20">Gen. xlviii, 19, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iii.ii-p5">31. The Camp of Daniel - The strongest camp next after
Judah, and therefore he comes in the rear, as Judah marched in the
front, that the tabernacle might be best guarded where there was most
danger.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="45.83%" prev="ii.v.iii.ii" next="ii.v.iv.i" id="ii.v.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. III" id="ii.v.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Num|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="45.83%" prev="ii.v.iv" next="ii.v.iv.ii" id="ii.v.iv.i">

<p id="ii.v.iv.i-p1">In this chapter we have an account,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.iv.i-p2">1. Of the priests, ver. 1-4.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.iv.i-p3">2. The work of the Levites, taken instead
of the first-born, ver. 5- 13.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.iv.i-p4">3. Of the number, place and charge of each
family; the Gershonites, ver. 14-26. The Kohathites, ver. 27-32. The
Merarites, ver. 33-39.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.iv.i-p5">4. Of the first-born, ver. 40-51.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter III" progress="45.84%" prev="ii.v.iv.i" next="ii.v.v" id="ii.v.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p1">1. These - Which follow in this chapter. The generations
- The kindred or family. Moses his family and children are here included
under the general name of the Amramites, ver. 27, which includes all the
children and grand-children of Amram, the persons only of Aaron and
Moses being excepted. And the generations of Moses are thus obscurely
mentioned, because they were but common Levites, the priesthood being
given solely to Aaron's posterity, whence Aaron is here put before
Moses, who elsewhere is commonly named after him. In Sinai - Nadab and
Abihu, were then alive, though dead at the time of taking this
account.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p2">4. In the sight of Aaron - Under his inspection and
direction, and as their father's servants or ministers in the priest's
office.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p3">6. Present them - Offer them to the Lord for his special
service. This was promised to them before, and now actually
conferred.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p4">7. His charge - That is, Aaron's, or those things which
are committed principally to Aaron's care and oversight. Of the
congregation - That is, of all the sacrifices and services which are due
to the Lord from all the people, because the people might not perform
them, in their own persons, therefore they were to be performed by some
particular persons in their stead; formerly by the first-born, chap.
viii, 16, and now by the Levites. Before the tabernacle - Not within the
tabernacle, for the care of the things within the holy place was
appropriated to the priests, as the care of the most holy place was to
the high-priest.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p5">8. Of the children of Israel - Those things which all the
children of Israel are in their several places and stations obliged to
take care of, though not in their persons, yet by others in their
stead.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p6">9. Given to him - To attend upon him and observe his
orders, and ease him of his burden.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p7">10. The stranger - That is, every one who is of another
family than Aaron's; yea, though he be a Levite. That cometh nigh - To
execute any part of the priest's office.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p8">12. The first-born - Who were God's property, <scripRef passage="Exod. xiii. 12" id="ii.v.iv.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Exod|13|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.13.12">Exod. xiii, 12</scripRef>, and to whom the administration of holy things was formerly
committed, which now was taken away from them, either because they had
forfeited this privilege by joining with the rest of their brethren in
the idolatrous worship of the calf, or because they were to be mainly
concerned in the distribution and management of the inheritances which
now they were going to possess, and therefore could not be at leisure to
attend upon the service of the sanctuary: and God would not commit it to
some other persons in each tribe, which might be an occasion of
idolatry, confusion, division, and contempt of sacred things, but to one
distinct tribe, which might be entirely devoted to that service, and
particularly to the tribe of Levi; partly out of his respect to Moses
and Aaron, branches of this tribe; partly as a recompence of their zeal
for God against idolaters, and partly because it was the smallest of the
tribes, and therefore most likely to find both employment in, and
maintenance for the work.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p9">15. From a month old - Because at that time the
first-born, in whose stead the Levites came, were offered to God. And
from that time the Levites were consecrated to God, and were, as soon as
capable, instructed in their work. Elsewhere they are numbered from
twenty-five years old, when they were entered as novices into part of
their work, chap. viii, 24, and from thirty years old, when they were
admitted to their whole office.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p10">25. The tabernacle - Not the boards, which belonged to
Merari, ver. 36, but the ten curtains. The tent - The curtains of goats
hair. The coverings - That is, the coverings of rams-skins and badgers-
skins.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p11">26. The cords - By which the tabernacle was fastened to
the pins, and stretched out, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxv. 18" id="ii.v.iv.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Exod|35|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.35.18">Exod. xxxv, 18</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p12">27. Of Kohath - This family had many privileges above the
others: of that were Moses and Aaron, and all the priests: they had the
chief place about the tabernacle, and the care of the most holy things
here, and in the land of Canaan they had twenty three cities, which were
almost as many as both their brethren received. Yet the posterity of
Moses were not at all dignified or distinguished from other Levites. So
far was he from seeking any advantage or honour for his own family.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p13">28. Keeping - That is, appointed for that work, as soon
as they were capable of it. Of the sanctuary - That is, of the holy
things contained in or belonging to the sanctuary.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p14">31. The hanging - Which covered the most holy place, for
all other hangings belonged to the Gershonites. The service - That is,
all the other furniture belonging to it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p15">32. Chief - Next under the high-priest; whence he is
called the second priest, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xxv. 18" id="ii.v.iv.ii-p15.1" parsed="|2Kgs|25|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.25.18">2 Kings xxv, 18</scripRef>, and in case of the high-priest's absence by sickness or
other necessary occasions, he was to perform his work, and he had a
superiority over all the rest of the priests and Levites. The chief of
the Levites - That is, over those three persons, who were each the chief
of their several families, ver. 24, 31, 34.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p16">38. For the charge - Either in their stead, that charge
which they were obliged to keep, if God had not committed it to those:
or for their benefit; for their preservation, as the word may be
rendered.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p17">39. Two and twenty thousand - If the particular numbers
mentioned ver. 22, 28, 34, be put together, they make 22,300. But the
odd 300 are omitted here, either according to the use of the holy
scripture, where in so great numbers small sums are commonly neglected,
or, because they were the first-born of the Levites, and therefore
belonged to God already, and so could not be given to him again instead
of the other first-born. If this number of first- born seem small to
come from 22,000 Levites, it must be considered, that only such
first-born are here named as were males, and such as continued in their
parents families, not such as had erected new families of their own. Add
to this, that God so ordered things by his wise providence for divers
weighty reasons, that this tribe should be much the least of all the
tribes, as is evident by comparing the numbers of the other tribes, from
twenty years old, chap. i, 3-49, with the number of this from a month
old; and therefore it is not strange if the number of their first-born
be less than in other tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p18">41. Instead of the first-born - Such as are now alive of
them, but those which should be born of them hereafter are otherwise
disposed. Of the Levites - Not that they were to be taken from the
Levites, or to be sacrificed to God, any more than the Levites
themselves were; but they together with the Levites were to be presented
before the Lord by way of acknowledgment, that the Levites might be set
apart for God's service, and their cattle for themselves as God's
ministers, and for their support in God's work.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p19">46. For those that are to be redeemed - 'Tis probable, in
the exchange they began with the eldest of the first-born, and so
downwards, so that those were to be redeemed, who were the two hundred,
seventy three youngest of them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.iv.ii-p20">47. Five shekels - Which was the price paid for the
redemption of a first-born a month old.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="45.96%" prev="ii.v.iv.ii" next="ii.v.v.i" id="ii.v.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. IV" id="ii.v.v-p0.1" parsed="|Num|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="45.96%" prev="ii.v.v" next="ii.v.v.ii" id="ii.v.v.i">

<p id="ii.v.v.i-p1">A command to number the Levites from thirty to fifty
years old, ver. 1-3. The charge of the Kohathites, ver. 4-20. Of the
Gershonites, ver. 21-28. Of the Merarites, ver. 29-33. The number of
each, ver. 34-45. Of all in general, ver. 46-49.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter IV" progress="45.97%" prev="ii.v.v.i" next="ii.v.vi" id="ii.v.v.ii">

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p1">3. From thirty - This age was prescribed, as the age of
full strength of body, and therefore most proper for their labourious
work of carrying the parts and vessels of the tabernacle, and of
maturity of judgment, which is necessary for the right management of
holy services. Whence even John and Christ entered not upon their
ministry till that age. Indeed their first entrance upon their work was
at their 25th year, when they began as learners, and acted under the
inspection and direction of their brethren; but in their 30th year they
were compleatly admitted to a full discharge of their whole office. But
David, being a prophet, and particularly directed by God in the affairs
of the temple, made a change in this matter, because the magnificence of
the temple, and the great multitude of sacred utensils and sacrifices,
required a greater number of attendants than formerly was necessary.
Until fifty - When they were exempted from the toilsome work of carrying
burdens, but not discharged from the honourable and easy work done
within the tabernacle, chap. viii, 26. All that enter - That is, that do
and may enter, having no defect, nor other impediment.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p2">5. They shall take down - For upon this necessary
occasion the inferior priests are allowed to come into the holy of
holies, which otherwise was peculiar to the high-priest. The covering
veil - The second veil, wherewith the ark was covered while the
tabernacle stood, <scripRef passage="Exod. xl. 3" id="ii.v.v.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Exod|40|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.40.3">Exod. xl, 3</scripRef>. Cover the ark - Because the Levites, who were to carry the
ark, might neither see, nor immediately touch it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p3">6. Badgers-skins - Whereby the ark was secured from the
injuries of the weather.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p4">7. The dishes - Upon which the shew-bread was put.
Continual bread - So called because it was continually to be there, even
in the wilderness; where though they had only manna for themselves, yet
they reserved corn for the weekly making of these loaves, which they
might with no great difficulty procure from some of the people bordering
upon the wilderness.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p5">11. The golden altar - All covered with plates of
gold.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p6">12. The instruments of ministry - The sacred garments
used by the priests in their holy ministrations. Cover them - All these
coverings were designed,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.v.ii-p7">1. For safety, that these holy things might
not be filled by rain, or tarnished by the sun.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.v.ii-p8">2. For decency, most of them had a cloth of
blue, or purple, or scarlet over them; the ark, a cloth wholly of blue,
perhaps an emblem of the azure skies, which are spread between us and
the Majesty on high;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.v.ii-p9">3. For concealment. It was a fit sign of
the darkness of that dispensation. The holy things were then covered.
But Christ hath now destroyed the face of the covering.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p10">13. The altar - Hence we may conclude, that they did
offer sacrifices at other times, though not so constantly and
diligently, as they did in Canaan. Moreover the taking away of the ashes
only doth sufficiently imply that the fire was preserved, which as it
came down from heaven, <scripRef passage="Lev. ix. 24" id="ii.v.v.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Lev|9|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.9.24">Lev. ix, 24</scripRef>. So it was by God's command to be continually fed, and kept
burning, and therefore doubtless was put into some vessel, which might
be either fastened to the altar and put within this covering, or carried
by some person appointed thereunto.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p11">15. Bear it - Upon their shoulders. Afterward the priests
themselves, being multiplied, carried these things, though the Levites
also were not excluded. They shall not touch - Before they are
covered.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p12">16. Eleazar - He himself is to carry these things, and
not to commit them to the sons of Kohath. The oversight - The care that
all the things above mentioned be carried by the persons and in the
manner expressed.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p13">18. Cut not off - Do not by your neglect provoke God to
cut them off for touching the holy things.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p14">19. To his service - To that which is peculiarly allotted
to him, the services, and burdens being equally distributed among
them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p15">25. The curtains - The curtains or covering of
goats-hair. The tabernacle - The ten curtains which covered the boards
of the tabernacle; for the boards themselves were carried by the
Merarites. His covering - The covering of rams-skins which was put next
over those ten curtains.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p16">26. Which is round about - Which court compassed both the
tabernacle and the altar.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p17">28. Under the hand - Under his conduct and direction.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p18">31. The sockets - Which were as the feet upon which the
pillars stood.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p19">32. Ye shall reckon - Every part and parcel shall be put
in an inventory; which is required here rather than in the fore-going
particulars; because these were much more numerous than the former;
because being meaner things, they might otherwise have been neglected;
and also to teach us, that God esteems nothing small in his service, and
that he expects his will should be observed in the minutest
circumstances. The death of the saints is represented us the taking down
of the tabernacle. The immortal soul, like the most holy things, is
first covered and taken away, carried by angels unseen, and care is
taken also of the body, the skin and flesh, which are as the curtains,
the bones and sinews, which are as the bars and pillars. None of these
shall be lost. Commandment is given concerning the bones, a covenant
made with the dust. They are in safe custody, and shall be produced in
the great day, when this tabernacle shall be set up again, and these
vile bodies made like the glorious body of Jesus Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.v.v.ii-p20">44. Three thousand - Here appears the wisdom of Divine
Providence, that whereas in the Kohathites and Gershonites, whose
burdens were fewer and easier, there were but about a third part of them
fit for service; the Merarites, whose burdens were more and heavier, had
above half of them fit for this work.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="46.07%" prev="ii.v.v.ii" next="ii.v.vi.i" id="ii.v.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. V" id="ii.v.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Num|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="46.07%" prev="ii.v.vi" next="ii.v.vi.ii" id="ii.v.vi.i">

<p id="ii.v.vi.i-p1">A command to remove the unclean out of the camp, ver.
1-4. Laws concerning restitution, ver. 5-10. The law concerning a woman
suspected of adultery, ver. 11-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter V" progress="46.07%" prev="ii.v.vi.i" next="ii.v.vii" id="ii.v.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p1">3. That they defile not the camp - By which God would
intimate the danger of being made guilty by other mens sins, and the
duty of avoiding intimate converse with wicked men. I dwell - By my
special and gracious presence.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p2">6. Any sin that men commit - Hebrew. any sins of men,
that is, sins against men, as deceits or wrongs, whereby other men are
injured, of which he manifestly speaks. Against the Lord - Which words
may be added, to shew that such injuries done to men are also sins
against God, who hath commanded justice to men, as well as religion to
himself. Guilty - That is, shall be sensible of his guilt, convicted in
his conscience.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p3">7. They shall confess their sin - They shall not continue
in the denial of the fact, but give glory to God, and take shame to
themselves by acknowledging it. The principal - That is, the thing he
took away, or what is equivalent to it. And add - Both as a compensation
to the injured person for the want of his goods so long, and as a
penalty upon the injurious dealer, to discourage others from such
attempts.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p4">8. No kinsman - This supposes the person injured to be
dead or gone, into some unknown place, and the person injured to be
known to the injurer. To the priest - Whom God appointed as his deputy
to receive his dues, and take them to his own use, that so he might more
cheerfully and entirely devote himself to the ministration of holy
things. This is an additional explication to that law, <scripRef passage="Lev. vi. 2" id="ii.v.vi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Lev|6|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.6.2">Lev. vi, 2</scripRef>, and for the sake thereof it seems here to be repeated.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p5">9. Unto the priest - To offer by his hands.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p6">10. Every man's hallowed things - Understand this not of
the sacrifices, because these were not the priest's peculiar, but part
of them was offered to God, and the remainder was eaten by the offerer
as well as by the priest; but of such other things as were devoted to
God, and could not be offered in sacrifice; as suppose a man consecrated
an house to the Lord, this was to be the priest's.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p7">12. If a man's wife - This law was given partly to deter
wives from adulterous practices, and partly to secure wives against the
rage of their hard-hearted husbands, who otherwise might upon mere
suspicions destroy them, or at least put them away. There was not like
fear of inconveniences to the husband from the jealousy, of the wife,
who had not that authority and power, and opportunity for the putting
away or killing the husband, as the husband had over the wife. Go aside
- From the way of religion and justice, and that either in truth, or in
her husband's opinion.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p8">15. The man shall bring her to the priest - Who first
strove to persuade her to own the truth. If she did, she was not put to
death, (which must have been, if it had been proved against her) but
only was divorced and lost her dowry. Her offering - By way of solemn
appeal to God, whom hereby she desired to judge between her and her
husband, and by way of atonement to appease God, who had for her sins
stirred up her husband against her. He shall pour no oil - Both because
it was a kind of sin-offering, from which these were excluded, and
because she came thither as a delinquent, or suspected of delinquency,
unpleasing both to God and men; as one that wanted that grace and
amiableness and joy which oil signified, and that acceptance with God
which frankincense denoted, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.v.vi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xli, 2. Bringing iniquity to
remembrance - Both to God before whom she appeared as a sinner, and to
her own conscience, if she was guilty; and, if she were not guilty of
this, yet it reminded her of her other sins, for which this might be a
punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p9">16. Before the Lord - That is, before the sanctuary where
the ark was.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p10">17. Holy water - Water of purification appointed for such
uses. This was used, that if she were guilty, she might be afraid to add
profaneness to her other crime. An earthen vessel - Because, after this
use, it was to be broken in pieces, that the remembrance of it might be
blotted out as far as was possible. Dust - An emblem of vileness and
misery. From the floor of the tabernacle - Which made it holy dust, and
struck the greater terror into the woman, if she were guilty.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p11">18. Before the Lord - Before the tabernacle with her face
towards the ark. Uncover her head - Partly that she might be made
sensible how manifest she and all her ways were to God; partly in token
of her sorrow for her sin, or at least for any cause of suspicion which
she had given. In her hands - That she herself might offer it, and
thereby call God to be witness of her innocency. Bitter - So called
either from the bitter taste which the dust gave it, or from the bitter
effects of it upon her, if she were guilty. That causeth the curse - Not
by any natural power, but by a supernatural efficacy.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p12">19. By an oath - To answer truly to his question, or to
declare whether she be guilty or no, and after such oath shall say as
follows.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p13">21. An oath - That is, a form of cursing, that when they
would curse a person, they may wish that they may be as miserable as
thou wast. Thy thigh - A modest expression, used both in scripture, as <scripRef passage="Gen. xlvi. 26" id="ii.v.vi.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Gen|46|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.46.26">Gen. xlvi, 26</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Exod. i. 5" id="ii.v.vi.ii-p13.2" parsed="|Exod|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.1.5">Exod. i, 5</scripRef>, and other authors. To rot - Hebrew. to fall, that is, to
die or waste away. To swell - Suddenly and violently till it burst,
which the Jews note was frequent in this case. And it was a clear
evidence of the truth of their religion.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p14">22. Amen, amen - That is, so let it be if I be guilty.
The word is doubled by her as an evidence of her innocency, and ardent
desire that God would deal with her according to her desert.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p15">23. In a book - That is, in a scroll of parchment, which
the Hebrews commonly call a book. Blot them out - Or scrape them out and
cast them into the bitter water. Whereby it was signified, that if she
was innocent, the curses should be blotted out and come to nothing; and,
if she were guilty, she should find in her the effects of this water
which she drank, after the words of this curse had been scraped and put
in.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p16">24. To drink - That is, after the jealousy-offering was
offered.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p17">28. Conceive seed - That is, shall bring forth children,
as the Jews say, in case of her innocency, she infallibly did, yea
though she was barren before.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vi.ii-p18">31. Guiltless - Which he should not have been, if he had
either indulged her in so great a wickedness, and not endeavoured to
bring her to repentance or punishment, or cherished suspicions in his
breast, and thereupon proceeded to hate her or cast her off. Whereas
now, whatsoever the consequence is, the husband shall not be censured
for bringing such curses upon her, or for defaming her, if she appear to
be innocent. Her iniquity - That is, the punishment of her iniquity,
whether she was false to her husband, or by any light carriage gave him
occasion to suspect her.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="46.19%" prev="ii.v.vi.ii" next="ii.v.vii.i" id="ii.v.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. VI" id="ii.v.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="46.19%" prev="ii.v.vii" next="ii.v.vii.ii" id="ii.v.vii.i">

<p id="ii.v.vii.i-p1">The law of the Nazarites. What they were to abstain from,
ver. 1-8. How to be cleansed from casual uncleanness, ver. 9-12. How to
be discharged from their vow, ver. 13-21. The form of blessing the
people, ver. 22-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter VI" progress="46.19%" prev="ii.v.vii.i" next="ii.v.viii" id="ii.v.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p1">2. Man or woman - For both sexes might make this vow, if
they were free and at their own disposal: otherwise their parents or
husbands could disannul the vow. A vow of a Nazarite - Whereby they
sequestered themselves from worldly employments and enjoyments, that
they might entirely consecrate themselves to God's service, and this
either for their whole lifetime, or for a less and limited space of
time.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p2">3. Nor eat grapes - Which was forbidden him for greater
caution to keep him at the farther distance from wine.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p3">4. All the days of his separation - Which were sometimes
more, sometimes fewer, as he thought fit to appoint.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p4">5. No razor - Nor scissors, or other instrument to cut
off any part of his hair. This was appointed, partly as a sign of his
mortification to worldly delights and outward beauty; partly as a
testimony of that purity which hereby he professed, because the cutting
off the hair was a sign of uncleanness, as appears from ver. 9, partly
that by the length of his hair he might be constantly minded of his vow;
and partly that he might reserve his hair entirely for God, to whom it
was to be offered. Holy - That is, wholly consecrated to God and his
service, whereby he shews that inward holiness was the great thing which
God required and valued in these, and consequently in other rites and
ceremonies.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p5">7. His father - Wherein he was equal to the high-priest,
being, in some sort, as eminent a type of Christ, and therefore justly
required to prefer the service of God, to which he had so fully given
himself, before the expressions of his affections to his dearest and
nearest relations. The consecration - That is, the token of his
consecration, namely, his long hair.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p6">9. He shall shave his head - Because his whole body, and
especially his hair was defiled by such an accident, which he ought to
impute either to his own heedlessness, or to God's providence so
ordering the matter, possibly for the punishment of his other sins, or
for the quickening him to more purity and detestation of all dead works,
whereby he would be defiled.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p7">11. A sin-offering - Because such a pollution was, though
not his sin, yet the chastisement of his sin. He sinned - That is,
contracted a ceremonial uncleanness, which is called sinning, because it
was a type of sin, and a violation of a law, tho' through ignorance and
inadvertency. Hallow - Begin again to hallow or consecrate it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p8">12. The days of his separation - As many days as he had
before vowed to God. Lost - Hebrew. fall, to the ground, that is, be
void or of none effect.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p9">14. A sin-offering - Whereby he confessed his
miscarriages, notwithstanding the strictness of his vow and all the
diligence which he could use, and consequently acknowledged his need of
the grace of God in Christ Jesus the true Nazarite. For peace- offerings
- For thankfulness to God, who had given him grace to make and in some
measure to keep such a vow. So he offered all the three sorts of
offerings, that he might so far fulfil all righteousness and profess his
obligation to observe the will of God in all things.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p10">15. Their meal-offering - Such as generally accompanied
the sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p11">18. At the door - Publickly, that it might be known that
his vow was ended, and therefore he was at liberty as to those things
from which he had restrained himself for a season, otherwise some might
have been scandalized at his use of his liberty. The fire - Upon which
the flesh of the peace-offerings was boiled.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p12">19. The shoulder - The left-shoulder, as it appears from
ver. 20, where this is joined with the heave-shoulder, which was the
right- shoulder, and which was the priests due in all sacrifices, <scripRef passage="Lev. vii. 32" id="ii.v.vii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Lev|7|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.7.32">Lev. vii, 32</scripRef>, and in this also. But here the other shoulder was added to
it, as a special token of thankfulness from the Nazarites for God's
singular favours vouchsafed unto them. The hands - That he may give them
to the priest, as his peculiar gift.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p13">20. May drink wine - And return to his former manner of
living.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p14">21. That his hand shall get - Besides what he shall
voluntarily give according to his ability.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p15">23. On this wise - Hebrew. Thus, or in these words: yet
they were not tied to these very words; because after this we have
examples of Moses and David and Solomon, blessing the people in other
words.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p16">24. Bless thee - Bestow upon you all manner of blessings,
temporal and spiritual. Keep thee - That is, continue his blessings to
thee, and preserve thee in and to the use of them; keep thee from sin
and its bitter effects.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p17">25. Shine upon thee - Alluding to the shining of the sun
upon the earth, to enlighten, and warm, and renew the face of it. The
Lord love thee, and make thee know that he loves thee. We cannot but be
happy, if we have God's love; and we cannot but be easy, if we know that
we have it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p18">26. Lift up his countenance - That is, look upon thee
with a chearful and pleasant countenance, as one that is well pleased
with thee and thy services. Peace - Peace with God, with thy own
conscience, and with all men; all prosperity is comprehended under this
word.</p>

<p id="ii.v.vii.ii-p19">27. Put my name - Shall call them by my name, shall
recommend them to me as my own people, and bless them and pray unto me
for them as such; which is a powerful argument to prevail with God for
them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="46.28%" prev="ii.v.vii.ii" next="ii.v.viii.i" id="ii.v.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. VII" id="ii.v.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="46.28%" prev="ii.v.viii" next="ii.v.viii.ii" id="ii.v.viii.i">

<p id="ii.v.viii.i-p1">The offerings of the princes upon the dedication of the
tabernacle, ver. 1-9. Upon the dedication of the altar, ver. 10-88,
Which God graciously accepts, ver. 89.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter VII" progress="46.29%" prev="ii.v.viii.i" next="ii.v.ix" id="ii.v.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p1">1. On the day - It seems day is for time, and on the day,
for about the time. For all the princes did not offer these things upon
one and the same day, but on several days, as here it follows. And so
this chapter comes in its proper place, and those things were done in
the second month of the second year after the tabernacle and altar, and
all other instruments thereof were anointed, as is here expressed; and
after the Levites were separated to the service of the tabernacle, and
appointed to their several works, which was done about a month after the
tabernacle was erected, and after the numbering of the people, chap. i,
2-49, when the princes here employed in the offerings were first
constituted; and after the disposal of the tribes about the tabernacle,
the order of which is here observed in the time of their offerings.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p2">2. Offered - In the manner and days hereafter
mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p3">3. Waggons - For the more convenient and safe carriage of
such things as were most cumbersome.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p4">5. According to his service - More or fewer, as the
nature of their service and of the things to be carried required.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p5">9. Upon their shoulders - Because of the greater worth
and holiness of the things which they carried.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p6">10. The altar - Of burnt-offerings, and incense too, as
appears from the matter of their offerings. Not for the first dedication
of them, for it is apparent they were dedicated or consecrated before
this time by Moses and Aaron: but for a farther dedication of them,
these being the first offerings that were made for any particular
persons or tribes. In the day - That is, about the time, as soon as it
was anointed.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p7">11. On his day - And in this offering they followed the
order of their camp, and not of their birth.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p8">13. Charger - A large dish or platter; to be employed
about the altar of burnt-offering, or in the court; not in the
sanctuary, for all its vessels were of gold.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p9">17. Peace-offerings - Which are more numerous because the
princes and priests, and some of the people made a feast before the Lord
out of them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p10">87. Their meal-offering - Which was not mentioned before,
because it was sufficiently understood from the law which required
it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p11">88. After it was anointed - Which words are very
conveniently added to explain in what sense he had so oft said, that
this was done in the day when it was anointed, namely, not exactly, but
in a latitude, a little after that it was anointed.</p>

<p id="ii.v.viii.ii-p12">89. To speak with him - To consult God upon occasion. The
mercy-seat - Which Moses standing without the veil could easily hear.
And this seems to be added in this place, to shew that when men had done
their part, God was not wanting in the performance of his part, and
promise. God's speaking thus to Moses by an audible voice, as if he had
been cloathed with a body, was an earnest of the incarnation of the Son
of God, when in the fulness of time the Word should be made flesh, and
speak in the language of the sons of men. That he who spake to Moses was
the Eternal Word, was the belief of many of the ancients. For all God's
communion with man is by his Son, who is the same yesterday, today and
forever.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="46.34%" prev="ii.v.viii.ii" next="ii.v.ix.i" id="ii.v.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. VIII" id="ii.v.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Num|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="46.34%" prev="ii.v.ix" next="ii.v.ix.ii" id="ii.v.ix.i">

<p id="ii.v.ix.i-p1">Directions concerning the lamps, ver. 1-4. Concerning
cleansing the Levites, ver. 5-8. Concerning the presenting them to God,
ver. 9-22. Concerning their age and service, ver. 23-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter VIII" progress="46.35%" prev="ii.v.ix.i" next="ii.v.x" id="ii.v.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p1">2. When thou lightest the lamps - The priests lighted the
middle lamp from the fire of the altar; and the rest one from another;
signifying that all light and knowledge comes from Christ, who has the
seven spirits of God, figured by the seven lamps of fire. Over against
the candlestick - On that part which is before the candlestick, Hebrew.
over against the face of the candlestick - That is, in that place
towards which the candlestick looked, or where the candlestick stood in
full view, that is, upon the north- side, where the table of shew-bread
stood, as appears from hence, because the candlestick stood close to the
boards of the sanctuary on the south-side, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxvi. 35" id="ii.v.ix.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|26|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.26.35">Exod. xxvi, 35</scripRef>. And thus the lights were on both sides of the sanctuary,
which was necessary, because it was dark in itself, and had no
window.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p2">4. Of beaten gold - Not hollow, but solid gold, beaten
out of one piece, not of several pieces joined or soldered together.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p3">7. Of purifying - Hebrew. of sin, that is, for the
expiation of sin. This water was mixed with the ashes of a red heifer,
chap. xix, 9, which therefore may seem to have been prescribed before,
though it be mentioned after; such kind of transplacings of passages
being frequent in scripture. Shave all their flesh - This external rite
signified the cutting off their inordinate desire of earthly things and
that singular purity of heart and life which is required in the
ministers of God.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p4">8. A young bullock - The same sacrifice which was offered
for a sin-offering for the whole congregation, because the Levites came
in the stead of all the first-born, who did in a manner represent the
whole congregation.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p5">10. The children of Israel - Not all of them, which was
impossible, but some in the name of all the princes or chiefs of each
tribe, who used to transact things in the name of their tribes. Put
their hands - Whereby they signified their transferring that right of
ministering to God from the first-born in whose hands it formerly was,
to the Levites, and their entire resignation and dedication of them to
God's service.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p6">11. For an offering - Hebrew. for a wave-offering. Not
that Aaron did so wave them, which he could not do, but that he caused
them to imitate that motion, and to wave themselves toward the several
parts of the world: whereby they might signify their readiness to serve
God, according to their capacity wheresoever they should be.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p7">12. Lay their hands - To signify that they were offered
by them and for them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p8">13. Set the Levites before Aaron - Give the Levites to
them, or to their service. Unto the Lord - For to him they were first
properly offered, and by him given to the priests in order to his
service.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p9">15. Go in - Into the court, where they were to wait upon
the priests at the altar of burnt-offering; and, at present, into the
tabernacle, to take it down and set it up.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p10">19. To do the service of Israel - To serve God in their
stead, to do what otherwise they had been obliged to do in their own
persons. To make an atonement - Not by offering sacrifices, which the
priests alone might do, but by assisting the priests in that expiatory
work, and by a diligent performance of all the parts of their office,
whereby God was pleased both with them and with the people. That there
be no plague - This is added as a reason why God appointed them to serve
in the tabernacle, that they might guard it, and not suffer any of the
people to come near it, or meddle with holy things, which if they did,
it would certainly bring a plague upon them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.ix.ii-p11">26. In the tabernacle - By way of advice, and assistance
in lesser and easier works.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="46.41%" prev="ii.v.ix.ii" next="ii.v.x.i" id="ii.v.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. IX" id="ii.v.x-p0.1" parsed="|Num|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="46.41%" prev="ii.v.x" next="ii.v.x.ii" id="ii.v.x.i">

<p id="ii.v.x.i-p1">Orders concerning eating the passover on the 14th day of
the first month, ver. 1-5. On the 14th day of the second month, by those
who had been hindered, ver. 8-12. Concerning the negligent and the
stranger, ver. 13, 14. Concerning the pillar of cloud and fire, ver.
15-23</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter IX" progress="46.41%" prev="ii.v.x.i" next="ii.v.xi" id="ii.v.x.ii">

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p1">1. In the first month - And therefore before the
numbering of the people, which was not till the second month, chap. i,
1, 2. But it is placed after it, because of a special case relating to
the passover, which happened after it, upon occasion whereof he mentions
the command of God for keeping the passover in the wilderness, which was
done but once, and without this command they had not been obliged to
keep it at all, till they came to the land of Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p2">6. They came - For resolution of their difficulty.</p>

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p3">7. An offering - Which if we neglect, we must be cut off,
and if we keep it in these circumstances, we must also be cut off. What
shall we do?</p>

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p4">10. Unclean or in a journey - Under these two instances
the Hebrews think that other hindrances of like nature are comprehended;
as if one be hindered by a disease, or by any other such kind of
uncleanness; which may seem probable both from the nature of the thing,
and the reason of the law which is the same in other cases.</p>

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p5">14. A stranger - Who is a proselyte.</p>

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p6">15. Namely, the tent of the testimony - Or, the
tabernacle above the tent of the testimony, that is, that part of the
tabernacle in which was the testimony, or the ark of the testimony; for
there the cloudy pillar stood. This was an evident token of God's
special presence with, and providence over them. And this cloud was
easily distinguished from other clouds, both by its peculiar figure and
by its constant residence in that place. Fire - That they might better
discern it and direct themselves and their journeys or stations by it.
Had it been a cloud only, it had scarce been visible by night: And had
it been a fire only, it would have been scarce discernable by day. But
God was pleased to give them sensible demonstrations, that he kept them
night and day.</p>

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p7">17. Was taken up - Or, ascended on high, above its
ordinary place, by which it became more visible to all the camp.</p>

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p8">18. The motion or stay of the cloud is fitly called the
command of God, because it was a signification of God's will and their
duty.</p>

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p9">19. The charge - That is, the command of God, that they
should stay as long as the cloud stayed.</p>

<p id="ii.v.x.ii-p10">21. When the cloud abode - This is repeated again and
again, because it was a constant miracle, and because it is a matter we
should take particular notice of, as highly significant and instructive.
It is mentioned long after by David, <scripRef passage="Psalm cv. 39" id="ii.v.x.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Ps|105|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.105.39">Psalm cv, 39</scripRef>, and by the people of God after their captivity, <scripRef passage="Neh. ix. 19" id="ii.v.x.ii-p10.2" parsed="|Neh|9|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.9.19">Neh. ix, 19</scripRef>. And the guidance of this cloud is spoken of, as signifying
the guidance of the Blessed Spirit, <scripRef passage="Isaiah lxiii. 14" id="ii.v.x.ii-p10.3" parsed="|Isa|63|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.63.14">Isaiah lxiii, 14</scripRef>. The Spirit of the Lord caused him to rest, and so didst
thou lead the people. And thus, in effect, does he guide, all those, who
commit their ways unto the Lord. So that they may well say, Father, thy
will be done! Dispose of me and mine as thou pleasest. Here I am,
waiting on my God, to journey and rest at the commandment of the Lord.
What thou wilt, and where thou wilt: only let me be thine, and always in
the way of my duty.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="46.47%" prev="ii.v.x.ii" next="ii.v.xi.i" id="ii.v.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. X" id="ii.v.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Num|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="46.47%" prev="ii.v.xi" next="ii.v.xi.ii" id="ii.v.xi.i">

<p id="ii.v.xi.i-p1">Orders concerning the silver trumpets, ver. 1-10. The
removal of the Israelites to Paran, ver. 11-28. The treaty of Moses with
Hobab, ver. 29-32. His prayer at the removal and resting of the ark,
ver. 33-36.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter X" progress="46.47%" prev="ii.v.xi.i" next="ii.v.xii" id="ii.v.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p1">2. Two trumpets - For Aaron's two sons: though afterwards
the number of the trumpets was much increased, as the number of the
priests also was. These trumpets were ordained, both for signification
of the great duty of ministers, to preach the word; and for use, as here
follows.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p2">6. For their journeys - As a sign for them to march
forward, and consequently for the rest to follow them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p3">9. Ye shall be saved - If you use this ordinance of God
with trust and dependance upon God for help.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p4">10. In the days of your gladness - Days appointed for
rejoicing and thanksgiving to God for former mercies, or deliverances.
Your solemn days - Your stated festivals. For a memorial - That God may
remember you for good to accept and bless you. God then takes pleasure
in our religious exercises, when we take pleasure in them. Holy work
should be done with holy joy.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p5">12. Paran - From which they travelled to other places,
and then returned into it again, chap. xii, 16.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p6">21. The others - The Gershonites, and Merarites, who
therefore marched after the first camp, a good distance from, and before
the Kohathites, that they might prepare the tabernacle for the reception
of its utensils, which the Kohathites brought some time after them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p7">29. Raguel - Called also Reuel, <scripRef passage="Exod. ii. 18" id="ii.v.xi.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Exod|2|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.2.18">Exod. ii, 18</scripRef>, who seems to be the same with Jethro; it being usual in
scripture for one person to have two or three names. And therefore this
Hobab is not Jethro, but his son, which may seem more probable, because
Jethro was old and unfit to travel, and desirous, as may well be
thought, to die in his own country, whither he returned, <scripRef passage="Exod. xviii. 27" id="ii.v.xi.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Exod|18|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.18.27">Exod. xviii, 27</scripRef>, but Hobab was young and fitter for these journeys, and
therefore entreated by Moses to stay and bear them company.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p8">30. I will not go - So he might sincerely say, though
afterward he was overcome by the persuasions of Moses.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p9">31. Thou mayest be to us instead of eyes - To direct and
guide us: for though the cloud determined them to a general place, yet
many particulars might be unknown to Moses, wherein Hobab, having long
lived in those parts, might be able to advise him, as concerning the
conveniences of water for their cattle, concerning the safety or danger
of the several parts, by reason of serpents or wild-beasts, or enemies,
in the parts adjoining to them, that so they might guard themselves
better against them. Or, this is to be understood of his directing them
not so much in their way. as about great and difficult matters, wherein
the counsel he had from God did not exclude the advice of men, as we see
in Hobab's father Jethro, <scripRef passage="Exod. xviii. 19-27" id="ii.v.xi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Exod|18|19|18|27" osisRef="Bible:Exod.18.19-Exod.18.27">Exod. xviii, 19-27</scripRef>. And it is probable, this was the wise son of a wise
father.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p10">33. Three days - With continued journeys; only it seems
probable, that the cloud made little pauses that they might have time
for sleep and necessary refreshments. The ark went before them - Altho'
in their stations it was in the middle, yet in their marches it went
before them; and the cloud was constantly over the ark whether it stood
or went; therefore the ark is said to go before and direct them, not as
if the ark could be seen of all the camps, which being carried only upon
mens shoulders was impossible; but because the cloud, which always
attended upon the ark, and did, together with the ark, constitute, in a
manner, one sign of God's presence, did lead and direct them. To search
out - A metaphorical expression, for discovering to them; for the ark
could not search, and God, who knew all places and things, needed not to
search.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p11">34. By day - And by night too, as was expressed before.
So we must learn to compare places of scripture, and to supply the
defects of one out of another, as we do in all authors.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xi.ii-p12">36. Return - Or, give rest, that is, a safe and quiet
place, free from enemies and dangers.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="46.54%" prev="ii.v.xi.ii" next="ii.v.xii.i" id="ii.v.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XI" id="ii.v.xii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="46.54%" prev="ii.v.xii" next="ii.v.xii.ii" id="ii.v.xii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xii.i-p1">The punishment of the murmurers stopt by the prayer of
Moses, ver. 1-3. The fresh murmuring of the people, ver. 4-6. The
description of manna, ver. 7-9. The murmuring of Moses, ver. 10- 16.
God's answer, ver. 16-23. The appointment of the seventy elders, ver.
24-30. Quails sent with a plague, ver. 31-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XI" progress="46.54%" prev="ii.v.xii.i" next="ii.v.xiii" id="ii.v.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p1">1. Complained - Or, murmured, the occasion whereof seems
to be their last three days journey in a vast howling wilderness, and
thereupon the remembrance of their long abode in the wilderness, and the
fear of many other tedious journeys, whereby they were like to be long
delayed from coming to the land of milk and honey, which they thirsted
after. The fire of the Lord - A fire sent from God in an extraordinary
manner, possibly from the pillar of cloud and fire, or from heaven. The
uttermost parts - Either because the sin began there among the mixed
multitude, or in mercy to the people, whom he would rather awaken to
repentance than destroy; and therefore he sent it into the skirts and
not the midst of the camp.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p2">2. The people - The murmurers, being penitent; or others
for fear.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p3">3. Taberah - This fire; as it was called
Kibroth-hattaavah from another occasion, ver. 34, 35, and chap. xxxiii,
16. It is no new thing in scripture for persons and places to have two
names. Both these names were imposed as monuments of the peoples sin and
of God's just judgment.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p4">4. Israel also - Whose special relation and obligation to
God should have restrained them from such carriage. Flesh - This word is
here taken generally so as to include fish, as the next words shew. They
had indeed cattle which they brought out of Egypt, but these were
reserved for breed to be carried into Canaan, and were so few that they
would scarce have served them for a month.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p5">5. Freely - Either without price, for fish was very
plentiful, and fishing was there free, or with a very small price. And
this is the more probable because the Egyptians might not taste of fish,
nor of the leeks and onions, which they worshipped for Gods, and
therefore the Israelites, might have them upon cheap terms.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p6">6. Our soul - Either our life, as the soul signifies, <scripRef passage="Gen. ix. 5" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Gen|9|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.9.5">Gen. ix, 5</scripRef>, or our body, which is often signified by the soul. Dried
away - Is withered and pines away; which possibly might be true, through
envy and discontent, and inordinate appetite.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p7">7. As coriander-seed - Not for colour, for that is black,
but for shape and figure. Bdellium - Is either the gum of a tree, of a
white and bright colour, or rather a gem or precious stone, as the
Hebrew doctors take it; and particularly a pearl wherewith the Manna
manifestly agrees both in its colour, which is white, <scripRef passage="Exod. xvi. 14" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Exod|16|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16.14">Exod. xvi, 14</scripRef>, and in its figure which is round.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p8">8. Fresh oil - Or, of the most excellent oil; or of cakes
made with the best oil, the word cakes being easily supplied out of the
foregoing member of the verse; or, which is not much differing, like
wafers made with honey, as it is said <scripRef passage="Exod. xvi. 31" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Exod|16|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16.31">Exod. xvi, 31</scripRef>. The nature and use of Manna is here thus particularly
described, to shew the greatness of their sin in despising such
excellent food.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p9">10. In the door of his tent - To note they were not
ashamed of their sin.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p10">11. Not found favour - Why didst thou not hear my prayer,
when I desired thou wouldest excuse me, and commit the care of this
unruly people to some other person.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p11">12. Have I begotten them? - Are they my children, that I
should be obliged to provide food and all things for their necessity and
desire?</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p12">14. To bear - The burden of providing for and satisfying
them. Alone - Others were only assistant to him in smaller matters; but
the harder and greater affairs, such as this unquestionably was, were
brought to Moses and determined by him alone.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p13">15. My wretchedness - Hebrew. my evil, my torment,
arising from the insuperable difficulty of my office and work of ruling
this people, and from the dread of their utter extirpation, and the
dishonour which thence will accrue to God and to religion, as if, not I
only, but God also were an impostor.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p14">16. To be elders - Whom thou by experience discernest to
be elders not only in years, and name, but also in wisdom and authority
with the people. And according to this constitution, the Sanhedrim, or
great council of the Jews, which in after-ages sat at Jerusalem, and was
the highest court of the judgment among them, consisted of seventy
men.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p15">17. I will come down - By my powerful presence and
operation. I will put it on them - That is, I will give the same spirit
to them which I have given to thee. But as the spirit was not conveyed
to them from or through Moses, but immediately from God, so the spirit
or its gifts were not by this means impaired in Moses. The spirit is
here put for the gifts of the spirit, and particularly for the spirit of
prophecy, whereby they were enabled, as Moses had been and still was, to
discern hidden and future things, and resolve doubtful and difficult
cases, which made them fit for government. It is observable, that God
would not, and therefore men should not, call any persons to any office
for which they were not sufficiently qualified.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p16">18. Sanctify themselves - Prepare to meet thy God, O
Israel, in the way of his judgments. Prepare yourselves by true
repentance, that you may either obtain some mitigation of the plague,
or, whilst your bodies are destroyed by the flesh you desire and eat,
your souls may be saved from the wrath of God. Sanctifying is often used
for preparing, as <scripRef passage="Jer. vi. 4" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Jer|6|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.6.4">Jer. vi, 4</scripRef>; xii, 3. In the ears of the Lord - Not secretly in your
closets, but openly and impudently in the doors of your tents, calling
heaven and earth to witness.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p17">20. At your nostrils - Which meat violently vomited up
frequently doth. Thus God destroys them by granting their desires, and
turns even their blessings into curses. Ye have despised the Lord - You
have lightly esteemed his bounty and manifold blessings, you have
slighted and distrusted his promises and providence after so long and
large experience of it. Who is among you - Who is present and resident
with you to observe all your carriage, and to punish your offenses. This
is added as a great aggravation of the crime, to sin in the presence of
the judge. Why came we forth out of Egypt? - Why did God do us such an
injury? Why did we so foolishly obey him in coming forth?</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p18">21. Six hundred thousand footmen - Fit for war, besides
women and children. That Moses speaks this as distrusting God's word is
evident; and that Moses was not remarkably punished for this as he was
afterward for the same sin, chap. xx, 12, may be imputed to the
different circumstances of this and that sin: this was the first offense
of the kind, and therefore more easily passed by; that was after warning
and against more light and experience. This seems to have been spoken
secretly: that openly before the people; and therefore it was fit to be
openly and severely punished to prevent the contagion of that
example.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p19">24. Moses went out - Out of the tabernacle, into which he
entered to receive God's answers from the mercy-seat. The seventy men -
They are called seventy from the stated number, though two of them were
lacking, as the Apostles are called the twelve, <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 20" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Matt|26|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.20">Matt. xxvi, 20</scripRef>, when one of that number was absent. Round the tabernacle -
Partly that the awe of God might be imprinted upon their hearts, that
they might more seriously undertake and more faithfully manage their
high employment, but principally, because that was the place where God
manifested himself, and therefore there he would bestow his spirit upon
them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p20">25. Rested on them - Not only moved them for a time, but
took up his settled abode with them, because the use and end of this
gift was perpetual. They prophesied - Discoursed of the word and works
of God in a marvelous manner, as the prophets did. So this word is used,
<scripRef passage="1 Sam. x. 5, 6" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p20.1" parsed="|1Sam|10|5|10|6" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.10.5-1Sam.10.6">1 Sam. x, 5, 6</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Joel ii. 28" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p20.2" parsed="|Joel|2|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Joel.2.28">Joel ii, 28</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="1 Cor. xiv. 3" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p20.3" parsed="|1Cor|14|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.14.3">1 Cor. xiv, 3</scripRef>. Yet were they not hereby constituted teachers, but civil
magistrates, who together with the spirit of government, received also
the spirit of prophesy, as a sign and seal both to themselves and to the
people, that God had called them to that employment. They did not cease
- Either for that day, they continued in that exercise all that day,
and, it may be, all the night too, as it is said of Saul, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xix. 24" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p20.4" parsed="|1Sam|19|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.19.24">1 Sam. xix, 24</scripRef>, or, afterwards also, to note that this was a continued gift
conferred upon them to enable them the better to discharge their
magistracy; which was more expedient for them than for the rulers of
other people, because the Jews were under a theocracy or the government
of God, and even their civil controversies were decided out of that word
of God which the prophets expounded.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p21">26. In the camp - Not going to the tabernacle, as the
rest did, either not having seasonable notice to repair thither: or,
being detained in the camp by sickness, or some urgent occasion, not
without God's special providence, that so the miracle might be more
evident. Were written - In a book or paper by Moses, who by God's
direction nominated the fittest persons.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p22">27. Told Moses - Fearing lest his authority should be
diminished by their prophesying; and thereby taking authority to
themselves without his consent.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p23">28. One of his young men - Or, one of his choice
ministers, which may be emphatically added, to note that even great and
good men may mistake about the works of God. Forbid them - He feared
either schism, or sedition, or that by their usurpation of authority,
independently upon Moses, his power and esteem might be lessened.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p24">29. Enviest thou for my sake - Art thou grieved because
the gifts and graces of God are imparted to others besides me? Prophets
- He saith prophets, not rulers, for that he knew was absurd and
impossible. So we ought to be pleased, that God is glorified and good
done, tho' to the lessening of our own honour.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p25">30. Into the camp - Among the people, to exercise the
gifts and authority now received.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p26">31. A wind from the Lord - An extraordinary and
miraculous wind both for its vehemency and for its effects. Quails - God
gave them quails once before, <scripRef passage="Exod. xvi. 13" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p26.1" parsed="|Exod|16|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16.13">Exod. xvi, 13</scripRef>, but neither in the same quantity, nor with the same design
and effect as now. From the sea - Principally from the Red-sea, and both
sides of it where, by the reports of ancient Heathen writers, they were
then in great numbers, and, no doubt, were wonderfully increased by
God's special providence for this very occasion. Two cubits high - Not
as if the quails did cover all the ground two cubits high for a day's
journey on each side of the camp, for then there had been no place left
where they could spread them all abroad round about the camp; but the
meaning is, that the quails came and fell down round about the camp for
a whole day's journey on each side of it, and that in all that space
they lay here and there in great heaps, which were often two cubits
high.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p27">32. Stood up - Or rather rose up, which word is often
used for beginning to do any business. All that night - Some at one
time, and some at the other, and some, through greediness or diffidence,
at both times. Ten homers - That is, ten ass loads: which if it seem
incredible, you must consider,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p28">1. That the gatherers here were not all the
people, which could not be without great inconveniences, but some on the
behalf of all, while the rest were exercised about other necessary
things. So the meaning is not, that every Israelite had so much for his
share, but that every collector gathered so much for the family, or
others by whom he was intrusted.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p29">2. That the people did not gather for their
present use only, but for a good while to come, and being greedy and
distrustful of God's goodness, it is not strange if they gathered much
more than they needed.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p30">3. That the word, rendered homers, may
signify heaps, as it doth, <scripRef passage="Exod. viii. 14" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p30.1" parsed="|Exod|8|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.8.14">Exod. viii, 14</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Judg. xv. 16" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p30.2" parsed="|Judg|15|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.15.16">Judg. xv, 16</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Hab. iii. 15" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p30.3" parsed="|Hab|3|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hab.3.15">Hab. iii, 15</scripRef>, and ten, is often put for many, and so the sense is, that
every one gathered several heaps. If yet the number seems incredible, it
must be farther known,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p31">4. That Heathen and other authors affirm,
in those eastern and southern countries quails are innumerable, so that
in one part of Italy, within the compass of five miles, there were taken
about an hundred thousand of them every day for a month together. And
Atheneus relates, that in Egypt, a country prodigiously populous, they
were in such plenty, that all those vast numbers of people could not
consume them, but were forced to salt and keep them for future use. They
spread them - That so they might dry, salt and preserve them for future
use, according to what they had seen in Egypt.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p32">33. Chewed - Hebrew. cut off, namely from their mouths. A
very great plague - Probably the pestilence. But the sense is, before
they had done eating their quails, which lasted for a month. Why did God
so sorely punish the peoples murmuring for flesh here, when he spared
them after the same sin, <scripRef passage="Exod. xvi. 12" id="ii.v.xii.ii-p32.1" parsed="|Exod|16|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16.12">Exod. xvi, 12</scripRef>. Because this was a far greater sin, and aggravated with
worse circumstances; proceeding not from necessity, as that did, when as
yet they had no food, but from mere wantonness, when they had Manna
constantly given them; committed after large experience of God's care
and kindness, after God had pardoned their former sins, and after God
had in a solemn and terrible manner made known his laws to them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xii.ii-p33">34. Kibroth-hattaavah - Hebrew. the graves of lust, that
is, of the men that lusted, as it here follows. And it notes that the
plague did not seize upon all that eat of the quails, for then all had
been destroyed, but only upon those who were inordinate both in the
desire and use of them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="46.78%" prev="ii.v.xii.ii" next="ii.v.xiii.i" id="ii.v.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XII" id="ii.v.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="46.78%" prev="ii.v.xiii" next="ii.v.xiii.ii" id="ii.v.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xiii.i-p1">Miriam and Aaron murmur against Moses, ver. 1-3. God
calls them to an account for it, ver. 4-9. Miriam becoming leprous,
Aaron humbles himself, and Moses prays for her, ver. 10-13. She is
healed, but shut out of the camp for seven days, ver. 14-16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XII" progress="46.78%" prev="ii.v.xiii.i" next="ii.v.xiv" id="ii.v.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p1">1. Miriam - Miriam seems to be first named, because she
was the first mover of the sedition; wherefore she is more eminently
punished. The Ethiopian - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p2">1. Zipporah, who is here called an
Ethiopian, in the Hebrew a Cushite, because she was a Midianite: the
word Cush being generally used in scripture, not for Ethiopia properly
so called below Egypt, but for Arabia. If she be meant, probably they
did not quarrel with him for marrying her, because that was done long
since, but for being swayed by her and her relations, by whom they might
think he was persuaded to chose seventy rulers, by which co-partnership
in government they thought their authority and reputation diminished.
And because they durst not accuse God, they charge Moses, his
instrument, as the manner of men is. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p3">2. some other woman, whom he married either
whilst Zipporah lived, or rather because she was now dead, though that,
as many other things, be not recorded. For, as the quarrel seems to be
about his marrying a stranger, it is probable it was a fresh occasion
about which they contended. And it was lawful for him as well as any
other to marry an Ethiopian or Arabian woman, provided she were, a
sincere proselyte.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p4">2. By us - Are not we prophets as well as he? so Aaron
was made, <scripRef passage="Exod. iv. 15, 16" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Exod|4|15|4|16" osisRef="Bible:Exod.4.15-Exod.4.16">Exod. iv, 15, 16</scripRef>, and so Miriam is called, <scripRef passage="Exod. xv. 20" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p4.2" parsed="|Exod|15|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.15.20">Exod. xv, 20</scripRef>. And Moses hath debased and mixed the holy seed, which we
have not done. Why then should he take all power to himself, and make
rulers as he pleaseth, without consulting us. The Lord heard - Observed
their words and carriage to Moses.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p5">3. Meek - This is added as the reason why Moses took no
notice of their reproach, and why God did so severely plead his cause.
Thus was he fitted for the work he was called to, which required all the
meekness he had. And this is often more tried by the unkindness of our
friends, than by the malice of our enemies. Probably this commendation
was added, as some other clauses were, by some succeeding prophet. How
was Moses so meek, when we often read of his anger? But this only
proves, that the law made nothing perfect.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p6">4. Suddenly - To stifle the beginnings of the sedition,
that this example might not spread amongst the people. Come out - Out of
your private dwellings, that you may know my pleasure and your own
doom.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p7">5. In the door - While they stood without, not being
admitted into the tabernacle, as Aaron used to be; a sign of God's
displeasure.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p8">6. Among you - if you be prophets, yet know there is a
difference among prophets, nor do I put equal honour upon all of
them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p9">7. In all my house - That is, whom I have set over all my
house, my church and people, and therefore over you; and who hath
discharged his office faithfully, and not partially as you falsely
accuse him.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p10">8. Mouth to mouth - That is, distinctly, by an articulate
voice; immediately, not by an interpreter, nor by shadows and
representations in his fancy, as it is in visions and dreams; and
familiarly. Apparently - Plainly and certainly. Dark speeches - Not in
parables, similitudes, dark resemblances; as by shewing a boiling pot,
an almond tree, &amp;c. to Jeremiah, a chariot with wheels, &amp;c. to
Ezekiel. The similitude - Not the face or essence of God, which no man
can see and live, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxiii. 20" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Exod|33|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.33.20">Exod. xxxiii, 20</scripRef>, but some singular manifestation of his glorious presence,
as <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxiii. 11, 20" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p10.2" parsed="|Exod|33|11|0|0;|Exod|33|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.33.11 Bible:Exod.33.20">Exod. xxxiii, 11, 20</scripRef>. Yea the Son of God appeared to him in an human shape, which
he took up for a time, that he might give him a foretaste of his future
incarnation. My servant - Who is so in such an eminent and extraordinary
manner.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p11">9. He departed - From the door of the tabernacle, in
token of his great displeasure, not waiting for their answer. The
removal of God~s presence from us, is the saddest token of his
displeasure. And he never departs, till we by our sin and folly drive
him from us.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p12">10. From the tabernacle - Not from the whole tabernacle,
but from that part, whither it was come, to that part which was directly
over the mercy-seat, where it constantly abode. Leprous - She, and not
Aaron, either because she was chief in the transgression or because God
would not have his worship interrupted or dishonoured, which it must
have been if Aaron had been leprous. White - This kind of leprosy was
the most virulent and incurable of all. It is true, when the leprosy
began in a particular part, and thence spread itself over all the flesh
by degrees, and at last made it all white, that was an evidence of the
cure of the leprosy, <scripRef passage="Lev. xiii. 12, 13" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Lev|13|12|13|13" osisRef="Bible:Lev.13.12-Lev.13.13">Lev. xiii, 12, 13</scripRef>. But it was otherwise when one was suddenly smitten with
this universal whiteness.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p13">11. Lay not the sin - Let not the guilt and punishment of
this sin rest upon us, upon her in this kind, upon me in any other kind,
but pray to God for the pardon and removal of it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p14">12. As one dead - Because part of her flesh was putrefied
and dead, and not to be restored but by the mighty power of God. Like a
still-born child, that hath been for some time dead in the womb, which
when it comes forth, is putrefied, and part of it consumed.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p15">14. Spit in her face - That is, expressed some eminent
token of indignation and contempt, which was this, <scripRef passage="Job xxx. 10" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Job|30|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.30.10">Job xxx, 10</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Isaiah l. 6" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p15.2" parsed="|Isa|50|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.50.6">Isaiah l, 6</scripRef>. Ashamed - And withdraw herself, from her father's presence,
as Jonathan did upon a like occasion, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xx. 34" id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p15.3" parsed="|1Sam|20|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.20.34">1 Sam. xx, 34</scripRef>. So though God healed her according to Moses's request, yet
he would have her publickly bear the shame of her sin, and be a warning
to others to keep them from the same transgression.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p16">15. Journeyed not - Which was a testimony of respect to
her both from God and from the people, God so ordering it, partly lest
she should be overwhelmed by such a publick rebuke from God, and partly
lest, she being a prophetess, the gift of prophesy should come into
contempt.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiii.ii-p17">16. Paran - That is, in another part of the same
wilderness.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="46.88%" prev="ii.v.xiii.ii" next="ii.v.xiv.i" id="ii.v.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XIII" id="ii.v.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|Num|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="46.88%" prev="ii.v.xiv" next="ii.v.xiv.ii" id="ii.v.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.v.xiv.i-p1">The sending of the spies into Canaan, ver. 1-17. The
instructions given them, ver. 18-20. Their journey and return, ver.
21-25. Their report, ver. 26-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XIII" progress="46.89%" prev="ii.v.xiv.i" next="ii.v.xv" id="ii.v.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p1">1. Speak unto Moses - In answer to the peoples petition
about it, as is evident from <scripRef passage="Deut. i. 22" id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Deut|1|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.1.22">Deut. i, 22</scripRef>. And it is probable, the people desired it out of diffidence
of God's promise.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p2">2. A ruler - A person of wisdom and authority.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p3">8. Oshea - Called also Joshua, ver. 16.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p4">11. Of Joseph - The name of Joseph is elsewhere
appropriated to Ephraim, here to Manasseh; possibly to aggravate the sin
of the ruler of this tribe, who did so basely degenerate from his noble
ancestor.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p5">16. Jehoshua - Oshea notes a desire of salvation,
signifying, Save we pray thee; but Jehoshua, or Joshua, includes a
promise of salvation, He will save. So this was a prophecy of his
succession to Moses in the government, and of the success of his arms.
Josh. is the same name with Jesus, of whom Joshua was a type. He was the
saviour of God's people from the powers of Canaan, Christ from the
powers of hell.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p6">17. Southward - Into the southern part of Canaan, which
was the nearest part, and the worst too, being dry and desert, and
therefore fit for them to enter and pass through with less observation.
Into the mountain - Into the mountainous country, and thence into the
valleys, and so take a survey of the whole land.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p7">18. What it is - Both for largeness, and for nature and
quality.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p8">19. In tents - As the Arabians did; or in unwalled
villages, which, like tents, are exposed to an enemy.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p9">20. Fat - Rich and fertile.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p10">21. Zin - In the south of Canaan, differing from the
wilderness of Sin, which was nigh unto Egypt. To Hamath - From the south
they passed through the whole land to the northern parts of it; Rehob
was a city in the northwest part, Hamath, a city in the northeast.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p11">22. By the south - Moses having described their progress
from south to north, more particularly relates some memorable places and
passages. They came - Hebrew. He came, namely, Caleb, as appears from <scripRef passage="Josh. xiv. 9" id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Josh|14|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.14.9">Josh. xiv, 9</scripRef>, 12, 14. For the spies distributed their work among them,
and went either severally, or by pairs; and it seems the survey of this
part was left to Caleb. Anak - A famous giant, whole children these are
called, either more generally, as all giants sometimes were, or rather
more specially because Arbah, from whom Hebron was called Kiriath-arbah,
was the father of Anak, <scripRef passage="Josh. xv. 13" id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p11.2" parsed="|Josh|15|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.15.13">Josh. xv, 13</scripRef>. And this circumstance is mentioned as an evidence of the
goodness of that land, because the giants chose it for their habitation.
Before Zoan - This seems to be noted to confront the Egyptians, who
vainly boasted of the antiquity of their city Zoan above all places.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p12">23. Upon a staff - Either for the weight of it,
considering the, length of the way they were to carry it, or for the
preservation of it whole and entire. In those eastern and southern
countries there are vines and grapes of an extraordinary bigness as
Strabo and Pliny affirm.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p13">24. Eschol - That is, a cluster of grapes.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p14">25. They returned after forty days - 'Tis a wonder the
people had patience to stay forty days, when they were just ready to
enter Canaan, under all the assurances of success they could have from
the Divine power, proved by a constant series of miracles, that had
hitherto attended them. But they distrusted God, and chose to be held in
suspence by their own counsels, rather than to rest upon God's promise!
How much do we stand in our own light by unbelief?</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p15">26. Kadesh - Kadesh-barnea, which some confound with
Kadesh in the wilderness of Sin, into which they came not 'till the
fortieth year after their coming out of Egypt, as appears from chap.
xxxiii, 37, 38, whereas they were in this Kadesh in the second year, and
before they received the sentence of their forty years abode in the
wilderness.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p16">27. They told him - In the audience of the people.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p17">29. The Amalekites in the south - Where we are to enter
the land, and they who were so fierce against us that they came into the
wilderness to fight with us, will, without doubt, oppose us when we come
close by their land, the rather, to revenge themselves for their former
loss. Therefore they mention them, though they were not Canaanites. In
the mountains -In the mountainous country, in the southeast part of the
land, so that you cannot enter there without great difficulty, both
because of the noted strength and valour of those people, and because of
the advantage they have from the mountains. By the sea - Not the
mid-land sea, which is commonly understood by that expression, but the
salt or dead sea, as appears,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p18">1. Because it is that sea which is next to
Jordan,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p19">2. Because the Canaanites dwelt principally
in those parts, and not near the mid-land sea. So these guard the
entrance on the east- side, as the others do on the south.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p20">30. Caleb - Together with Joshua, as is manifest from
chap. xiv, 6, 7, 30, but Caleb alone is here mentioned, possibly because
he spake first and most, which he might better do, because he might be
presumed to be more impartial than Joshua, who being Moses's minister
might be thought to speak only what he knew his master would like.
Stilled the people -Which implies either that they had began to murmur,
or that by their looks and carriage, they discovered the anger which
boiled in their breasts. Before Moses - Or, towards Moses, against whom
they were incensed, as the man who had brought them into such sad
circumstances. Let us go up and possess it - He does not say, Let us go
up and conquer it. He looks on that to be as good as done already: but,
Let us go up and possess it! There is nothing to be done, but to enter
without delay, and take the possession which our great Lord is now ready
to give us! Thus difficulties that lie in the way of salvation, vanish
away before a lively faith.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p21">31. The men - All of them, Joshua excepted. Stronger -
Both in stature of body and numbers of people. Thus they question the
power, and truth, and goodness of God, of all which they had such ample
testimonies.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p22">32. Eateth up its inhabitants - Not so much by civil
wars, for that was likely to make their conquest more easy; but rather
by the unwholesomeness of the air and place, which they guessed from the
many funerals, which, as some Hebrew writers, not without probability
affirm, they observed in their travels through it: though that came to
pass from another cause, even from the singular providence of God,
which, to facilitate the Israelites conquest, cut off vast numbers of
the Canaanites either by a plague, or by the hornet sent before them, as
is expressed, <scripRef passage="Josh. xxiv. 12" id="ii.v.xiv.ii-p22.1" parsed="|Josh|24|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.24.12">Josh.
xxiv, 12</scripRef>.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="47.00%" prev="ii.v.xiv.ii" next="ii.v.xv.i" id="ii.v.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XIV" id="ii.v.xv-p0.1" parsed="|Num|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="47.00%" prev="ii.v.xv" next="ii.v.xv.ii" id="ii.v.xv.i">

<p id="ii.v.xv.i-p1">The murmuring of the people against Moses and Aaron, ver.
1-4. Their fruitless endeavour to still them, ver. 5-10. God's
threatening utterly to destroy them, ver. 11-12. The intercession of
Moses, ver. 13-19. The decree that all that generation should die in the
wilderness, ver. 20-35. The immediate death of the spies, ver. 36-39.
The ill success of those who would go up notwithstanding, ver.
40-45.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XIV" progress="47.01%" prev="ii.v.xv.i" next="ii.v.xvi" id="ii.v.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p1">2. Against Moses and Aaron - As the instruments and
occasions of their present calamity. That we had died in this wilderness
- It was not long before they had their desire, and did die in the
wilderness.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p2">3. The Lord - From instruments they rise higher, and
strike at God the cause and author of their journey: by which we see the
prodigious growth and progress of sin when it is not resisted. A prey -
To the Canaanites whose land we were made to believe we should
possess.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p3">4. A captain - Instead of Moses, one who will be more
faithful to our interest than he. Into Egypt - Stupendous madness!
Whence should they have protection against the hazards, and provision
against all the wants of the wilderness? Could they expect either God's
cloud to cover and guide them, or Manna from heaven to feed them? Who
could conduct them over the Red-sea? Or, if they went another way, who
should defend them against those nations whose borders they were to
pass? What entertainment could they expect from the Egyptians, whom they
had deserted and brought to so much ruin?</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p4">5. Fell on their faces - As humble and earnest suppliants
to God, the only refuge to which Moses resorted in all such straits, and
who alone was able to govern this stiff-necked people. Before all the
assembly -That they might awake to apprehend their sin and danger, when
they saw Moses at his prayers, whom God never failed to defend, even
with the destruction of his enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p5">6. Rent their clothes - To testify their hearty grief for
the peoples blasphemy against God and sedition against Moses, and that
dreadful judgment which they easily foresaw this must bring upon the
congregation.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p6">8. Delight in us - If by our rebellion and ingratitude we
do not provoke God to leave and forsake us.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p7">9. Bread - We shall destroy them as easily as we eat our
bread. Their defense - Their conduct and courage, and especially God,
who was pleased to afford them his protection 'till their iniquities
were full, is utterly departed from them, and hath given them up as a
prey to us. With us - By his special grace and almighty power, to save
us from them and all our enemies. Only rebel not against the Lord -
Nothing can ruin sinners but their own rebellion. If God leaves them,
'tis because they drive him from them, and they die, because they will
die.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p8">10. Appeared - Now in the extremity of danger to rescue
his faithful servants, and to stop the rage of the people. In the
tabernacle - Upon or above the tabernacle, where the cloud usually
resided, in which the glory of God appeared now in a more illustrious
manner. When they reflected upon God, his glory appeared not, to silence
their blasphemies: but when they threatened Caleb and Joshua, they
touched the apple of his eye, and his glory appeared immediately. They
who faithfully expose themselves for God, are sure of his special
provision.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p9">12. I will smite them - This was not an absolute
determination, but a commination, like that of Nineveh's destruction,
with a condition implied, except there be speedy repentance, or powerful
intercession.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p10">16. Not able - His power was quite spent in bringing them
out of Egypt, and could not finish the work he had begun and had sworn
to do.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p11">17. Be great - That is appear to be great, discover its
greatness: namely, the power of his grace and mercy, or the greatness of
his mercy, in pardoning this and their other sins: for to this the
following words manifestly restrain it, where the pardon of their sins
is the only instance of this power both described in God's titles, ver.
18, and prayed for by Moses ver. 19, and granted by God in answer to
him, xiv, 20. Nor is it strange that the pardon of sin, especially such
great sins, is spoken of as an act of power in God, because undoubtedly
it is an act of omnipotent and infinite goodness.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p12">18. Visiting the iniquity - These words may seem to be
improperly mentioned, as being a powerful argument to move God to
destroy this wicked people, and not to pardon them. It may be answered,
that Moses useth these words together with the rest, because he would
not sever what God had put together. But the truer answer seems to be,
that these words are to be translated otherwise, And in destroying he
will not utterly destroy, though he visit the iniquity of the fathers
upon the children, unto the third and fourth generation.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p13">20. I have pardoned - So far as not utterly to destroy
them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p14">21. With the glory of the Lord - With the report of the
glorious and righteous acts of God in punishing this rebellious
people.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p15">22. My glory - That is, my glorious appearances in the
cloud, and in the tabernacle. Ten times - That is, many times. A certain
number for an uncertain.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p16">24. Caleb - Josh. is not named, because he was not now
among the people, but a constant attendant upon Moses, nor was he to be
reckoned as one of them, any more than Moses and Aaron were, because he
was to be their chief commander. He had another spirit - Was a man of
another temper, faithful and courageous, not acted by that evil spirit
of cowardice, unbelief, disobedience, which ruled in his brethren but by
the spirit of God. Fully - Universally and constantly, through
difficulties and dangers, which made his partners halt. Whereinto he
went - In general, Canaan, and particularly Hebron, and the adjacent
parts, <scripRef passage="Josh. xiv. 9" id="ii.v.xv.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Josh|14|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.14.9">Josh. xiv, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p17">25. In the valley - Beyond the mountain, at the foot
whereof they now were, ver. 40. And this clause is added, either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xv.ii-p18">1. As an aggravation of Israel's misery and
punishment, that being now ready to enter and take possession of the
land, they are forced to go back into the wilderness or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xv.ii-p19">2. As an argument to oblige them more
willingly to obey the following command of returning into the
wilderness, because their enemies were very near them, and severed from
them only by that Idumean mountain, and, if they did not speedily
depart, their enemies would fall upon them, and so the evil which before
they causelessly feared would come upon them; they, their wives and
their children, would become a prey to the Amalekites and Canaanites,
because God would not assist nor defend them. By the way of the Red-sea
- That leadeth to the Red-sea, and to Egypt, the place whither you
desire to return.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p20">28. As ye have spoken - When you wickedly wished you
might die in the wilderness.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p21">30. You - Your nation; for God did not swear to do so to
these particular persons.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p22">32. Your carcases - See with what contempt they are
spoken of, now they had by their sin made themselves vile! The mighty
men of valour were but carcases, now the Spirit of the Lord was departed
from them! It was very probably upon this occasion, that Moses wrote the
ninetieth psalm.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p23">33. Forty years - So long as to make up the time of your
dwelling in the wilderness forty years; one whole year and part of
another were past before this sin or judgment. Your whoredoms - The
punishment of your whoredoms, of your apostacy from, and perfidiousness
against your Lord, who was your husband, and had married you to
himself.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p24">34. Each day for a year - So there should have been forty
years to come, but God was pleased mercifully to accept of the time past
as a part of that time. Ye shall know my breach of promise - That as you
have first broken the covenant between you and me, by breaking the
conditions of it, so I will make it void on my part, by denying you the
blessings promised in that covenant. So you shall see, that the breach
of promise wherewith you charged me, lies at your door, and was forced
from me by your perfidiousness.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p25">37. By the plague - Either by the pestilence, or by some
other sudden and extraordinary judgment, sent from the cloud in which
God dwelt, and from whence he spake to Moses, and wherein his glory at
this time appeared before all the people, ver. 10, who therefore were
all, and these spies among the rest, before the Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p26">38. But Joshua and Caleb lived still - Death never misses
his mark, nor takes any by oversight who are designed for life, tho' in
the midst of those that are to die.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p27">39. And the people mourned greatly - But it was now too
late. There was now no place for repentance. Such mourning as this there
is in hell; but the tears will not quench the flames.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p28">40. Gat them up - Designed or prepared themselves to go
up.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xv.ii-p29">45. The Canaanites - Largely so called, but strictly the
Amorites. Hormah - A place so called afterwards, ver. 3, from the
slaughter or destruction of the lsraelites at this time.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="47.16%" prev="ii.v.xv.ii" next="ii.v.xvi.i" id="ii.v.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XV" id="ii.v.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|Num|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="47.16%" prev="ii.v.xvi" next="ii.v.xvi.ii" id="ii.v.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.v.xvi.i-p1">Laws, concerning meal-offerings and drink offerings, ver.
1- 16. Concerning dough for heave-offerings, ver. 17-21. Sacrifices for
sins of ignorance, ver. 22-29. Concerning presumptuous sinners, ver. 30,
31. An instance in the sabbath-breaker, ver. 32- 36. Concerning fringes
on the borders of their garments, ver. 37- 41.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XV" progress="47.16%" prev="ii.v.xvi.i" next="ii.v.xvii" id="ii.v.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p1">2. I give you - Will certainly give you, not withstanding
this great provocation. And for their better assurance hereof he repeats
and amplifies the laws of sacrifices, whereby through Christ he would be
reconciled to them and theirs upon their repentance.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p2">3. A sacrifice - A peace-offering.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p3">4. A tenth deal - The tenth part of an Ephah, that is,
about five pints. An hin contained about five quarts.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p4">6. Two tenth-deals - Because this belonged to a better
sacrifice than the former; and therefore in the next sacrifice of a
bullock, there are three tenth deals. So the accessory sacrifice grows
proportionably with the principal.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p5">8. Peace-offerings - Such as were offered either freely
or by command, which may be called peace-offerings or thank- offerings,
by way of eminency, because such are offered purely by way of gratitude
to God, and with single respect to his honour, whereas the
peace-offerings made in performance of a vow were made and offered, with
design of getting some advantage by them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p6">12. Their number - As many cattle as ye sacrifice, so
many meal and drink-offerings ye shall offer.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p7">15. Before the Lord - As to the worship of God: his
sacrifices shall be offered in the same manner and accepted by God upon
the same terms, as yours: which was a presage of the future calling of
the Gentiles. And this is added by way of caution, to shew that
strangers were not upon this pretense to partake of their civil
privileges.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p8">19. When ye eat - When you are about to eat it: for
before they eat it, they were to offer this offering to God. The bread -
That is, the bread-corn.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p9">20. The threshing floor - That is, of the corn in the
threshing floor, when you have gathered in your corn.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p10">22. All these commandments - Those now spoken of, which
concern the outward service of God, or the rites or ceremonies belonging
to it. And herein principally this law may seem to differ from that <scripRef passage="Lev. iv. 13" id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Lev|4|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.4.13">Lev. iv, 13</scripRef>, which speaks of some positive miscarriage, or doing that
which ought not to have been done, about the holy things of God; whereas
this speaks only of an omission of something which ought to have been
done about holy ceremonies.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p11">30. Reproacheth the Lord - He sets God at defiance, and
exposeth him to contempt, as if he were unable to punish
transgressors.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p12">32. On the sabbath-day - This seems to be added as an
example of a presumptuous sin: for as the law of the sabbath was plain
and positive, so this transgression of it must needs be a known and
wilful sin.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p13">33. To all the congregation - That is, to the rulers of
the congregation.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p14">34. They - That is, Moses and Aaron, and the seventy
rulers. What should be done - That is, in what manner he was to be cut
off, or by what kind of death he was to die, which therefore God here
particularly determines: otherwise it was known in general that
sabbath-breakers were to be put to death.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p15">38. Fringes - These were certain threads or ends,
standing out a little further than the rest of their garments, lest
there for this use. In the borders - That is, in the four borders or
quarters, as it is, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxii. 12" id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Deut|22|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.22.12">Deut. xxii, 12</scripRef>. Of their garments - Of their upper garments. This was
practiced by the Pharisees in Christ's time, who are noted for making
their borders larger than ordinary. A ribband - To make it more obvious
to the sight, and consequently more serviceable to the use here
mentioned. Of blue - Or, purple.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p16">39. For a fringe - That is, the ribband, shall be unto
you, shall serve you for a fringe, to render it more visible by its
distinct colour, whereas the fringe without this was of the same piece
and colour with the garment, and therefore less observeable. That ye
seek not - Or, inquire not for other rules and ways of serving me than I
have prescribed you. Your own heart, and eyes - Neither after the
devices of your own hearts, as Nadab and Abihu did when they offered
strange fire; nor after the examples of others which your eyes see, as
you did when you were set upon worshipping a calf after the manner of
Egypt. The phylacteries worn by the Pharisees in our Lord's time, were a
different thing from these. Those were of their own invention: these
were a divine institution.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p17">40. Be ye holy - Purged from sin and sincerely devoted to
God.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvi.ii-p18">41. I am the Lord your God - Though I am justly
displeased with you for your frequent rebellions, for which also I will
keep you forty years in the wilderness, yet I will not utterly cast you
off, but will continue to be your God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="47.24%" prev="ii.v.xvi.ii" next="ii.v.xvii.i" id="ii.v.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XVI" id="ii.v.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="47.24%" prev="ii.v.xvii" next="ii.v.xvii.ii" id="ii.v.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xvii.i-p1">Korah, Dathan and Abiram, rise up against Moses, ver.
1-4. Moses reasons with them, ver. 5-11. Sends for Dathan and Abiram,
who refuse to come, ver. 12-14. His proposal to Korah, ver. 15-19. The
punishment of the rebels, ver. 20-35. Their censers preserved for a
memorial, ver. 36-40. A new insurrection stopped by a plague, ver.
41-45. Aaron stays the plague, ver. 46- 50.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XVI" progress="47.25%" prev="ii.v.xvii.i" next="ii.v.xviii" id="ii.v.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p1">1. The son of Izhar - Amram's brother, <scripRef passage="Exod. vi. 18" id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|6|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.6.18">Exod. vi, 18</scripRef>, therefore Moses and he were cousin germans. Moreover, Izhar
was the second son of Kohath, whereas Elizaphan, whom Moses had
preferred before him, and made prince or ruler of the Kohathites, chap.
iii, 30, was the son of Uzziel, the fourth son of Kohath. This, the
Jewish writers say, made him malcontent, which at last broke forth into
sedition. Sons of Reuben - These are drawn into confederacy with Korah,
partly because they were his next neighbours, both being encamped on the
south-side, partly in hopes to recover their rights of primogeniture, in
which the priesthood was comprehended, which was given away from their
father.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p2">2. Rose up - That is, conspired together, and put their
design in execution. Before Moses - Not obscurely, but openly and
boldly, not fearing nor regarding the presence of Moses.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p3">3. They - Korah, Dathan and Abiram, and the rest, who
were all together when Moses spake those words, ver. 5-7, but after
that, Dathan and Abiram retired to their tents, and then Moses sent for
Korah and the Levites, who had more colourable pretenses to the
priesthood, and treats with them apart, and speaks what is mentioned,
ver. 8-11. Having dispatched them, he sends for Dathan and Abiram, ver.
12, that he might reason the case with them also apart. Against Aaron -
To whom the priesthood was confined, and against Moses, both because
this was done by his order, and because before Aaron's consecration
Moses appropriated it to himself. For whatever they intended, they seem
not now directly to strike at Moses for his supreme civil government,
but only for his influence in the disposal of the priesthood. Ye take
too much - By perpetuating the priesthood in yourselves and family, with
the exclusion of all others from it. All are holy - A kingdom of
priests, an holy nation, as they are called, <scripRef passage="Exod. xix. 6" id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Exod|19|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.19.6">Exod. xix, 6</scripRef>, a people separated to the service of God, and therefore no
less fit to offer sacrifice and incense, than you are. Among them - By
his tabernacle and cloud, the tokens of his gracious presence, and
therefore ready to receive sacrifices from their own hands. Ye - Thou
Moses, by prescribing what laws thou pleasest about the priesthood, and
confining it to thy brother; and thou Aaron by usurping it as thy
peculiar privilege.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p4">4. On his face - Humbly begging that God would direct and
vindicate him. Accordingly God answers his prayers, and strengthens him
with new courage, and confidence of success.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p5">5. Tomorrow - Hebrew. In the morning, the time appointed
by men for administering justice, and chosen by God for that work. Some
time is allowed, partly that Korah and his company might prepare
themselves and their censers, and partly to give them space for
consideration and repentance. He will cause him - He will by some
evident token declare his approbation of him and his ministry.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p6">8. Ye sons of Levi - They were of his own tribe, nay,
they were of God's tribe. It was therefore the worse in them thus to
mutiny against God and against him.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p7">9. To minister to them - So they were the servants both
of God and of the church, which was an high dignity, though not
sufficient for their ambitious minds.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p8">11. Against the Lord - Whose chosen servant Aaron is. You
strike at God through Aaron's sides.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p9">12. Dathan and Abiram - To treat with them and give them,
as he had done Korah and his company, a timely admonition. Come up - To
Moses's tabernacle, whither the people used to go up for judgment. Men
are said in scripture phrase to go up to places of judgment.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p10">14. These men - Of all the people who are of our mind:
wilt thou make them blind, or persuade them that they do not see what is
visible to all that have eyes, to wit, that thou hast deceived them, and
broken thy faith and promise given to them?</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p11">15. Respect not their offering - Accept not their incense
which they are now going to offer, but shew some eminent dislike of it.
He calls it their offering, though it was offered by Korah and his
companions, because it was offered in the name and by the consent of all
the conspirators, for the decision of the present controversy between
them and Moses. I have not hurt one of them - I have never injured them,
nor used my power to defraud or oppress them, as I might have done; I
have done them many good offices, but no hurt: therefore their crime is
without any cause or provocation.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p12">16. Before the Lord - Not in the tabernacle, which was
not capable of so many persons severally offering incense, but at the
door of the tabernacle, where they might offer it by Moses's direction
upon this extraordinary occasion. This work could not be done in that
place, which alone was allowed for the offering up of incense; not only
for its smallness, but also because none but priests might enter to do
this work. Here also the people, who were to be instructed by this
experiment, might see the proof and success of it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p13">18. Fire - Taken from the altar which stood in that
place, for Aaron might not use other fire. And it is likely the
rememberance of the death of Nadab and Abihu deterred them from offering
any strange fire.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p14">19. Against them - That they might be witnesses of the
event, and, upon their success, which they doubted not of, might fall
upon Moses and Aaron. And it seems by this that the people were
generally incensed against Moses, and inclined to Korah's side. The
glory appeared -In the cloud, which then shone with greater brightness
and majesty, as a token of God's approach and presence.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p15">22. The spirits - And this is no empty title here, but
very emphatical. Thou art the maker of spirits, destroy not thy own
workmanship! O thou who art the preserver of men, and of their spirits,
the Lord of spirits, <scripRef passage="Job xii. 10" id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Job|12|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.12.10">Job xii, 10</scripRef>, who as thou mayst justly destroy this people, so thou canst
preserve whom thou pleasest: the father of spirits, the souls. Deal
mercifully with thy own children: the searcher of spirits, thou canst
distinguish between those who have maliciously railed this tumult, and
those whose ignorance and simple credulity hath made them a prey to
crafty seducers. Of all flesh - Of all mankind: the word flesh is often
put for men. One man - Korah, the ringleader of this sedition.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p16">24. The congregation - Whom for your sakes I will spare
upon the condition following.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p17">25. Unto Dathan - Because they refused to come to him.
The elders - The seventy rulers, whom he carried with him for the
greater solemnity of the action, and to encourage them in their work,
notwithstanding the obstinate and untractable nature of the people they
were to govern.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p18">27. Stood in the door - An argument of their foolish
confidence, obstinacy and impenitency, whereby they declared that they
neither feared God, nor reverenced man.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p19">28. All these works - As the bringing of the people out
of Egypt; the conducting of them through the wilderness; the exercising
authority among them; and giving laws to them concerning the
priesthood.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p20">29. The death of all men - By a natural death. The
visitation of all men - By plague, or sword, or some usual judgment. The
Lord hath not sent me - I am content that you take me for an imposter,
falsely pretending to be sent of God.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p21">32. All that appertained unto Korah - That is, all his
family which were there, women, children, and servants; but his sons,
who were spared, chap. xxvi, 11, 58; <scripRef passage="1 Chron. vi. 22, 37" id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p21.1" parsed="|1Chr|6|22|0|0;|1Chr|6|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.6.22 Bible:1Chr.6.37">1 Chron. vi, 22, 37</scripRef>, were absent either upon some service of the tabernacle, or
upon some other occasion, God so ordering it by his providence either
because they disliked their fathers act, or upon Moses's intercession
for them. This expression may intimate, that Korah himself was not here,
but that he continued with his two hundred and fifty men before the
Lord, where they were waiting for God's decision of the controversy. Nor
is it probable that their chief captain would desert them, and leave
them standing there without an head, especially, when Aaron his great
adversary, abode there still, and did not go with Moses to Dathan. And
Korah may seem to have been consumed with those two hundred and fifty.
And so much is intimated, ver. 40, that no stranger come near to offer
incense before the Lord, that he be not as Korah, and as his company,
that is, destroyed, as they were, by fire from the Lord. And when the
Psalmist relates this history, <scripRef passage="Psalm cvi. 17-18" id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p21.2" parsed="|Ps|106|17|106|18" osisRef="Bible:Ps.106.17-Ps.106.18">Psalm cvi, 17-18</scripRef>, the earth's swallowing them up is confined to Dathan and
Abiram, <scripRef passage="Psalm cvi. 17" id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p21.3" parsed="|Ps|106|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.106.17">Psalm cvi, 17</scripRef>, and for all the rest of that conspiracy it is added, <scripRef passage="Psalm cvi. 18" id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p21.4" parsed="|Ps|106|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.106.18">Psalm cvi, 18</scripRef>. And a fire was kindled in their company, the flame burnt up
the wicked.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p22">33. Into the pit - Into the earth, which first opened
itself to receive them, and then shut itself to destroy them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p23">35. From the Lord - From the cloud, wherein the glory of
the Lord appeared.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p24">37. To Eleazer - Rather than to Aaron, partly because the
troublesome part of the work was more proper for him, and partly lest
Aaron should be polluted by going amongst those dead carcasses; for it
is probable this fire consumed them, as lightning sometimes doth,
others, by taking away their lives, and leaving their bodies dead upon
the place. Out of the burning - From among the dead bodies of those men
who were burnt. Yonder - Far from the altar and sanctuary, into an
unclean place, where the ashes were wont to be cast: by which God shews
his rejection on of their services. They are hallowed - By God's
appointment, because they were presented before the Lord by his express
order, ver. 16, 17.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p25">38. Their own souls - That is, their own lives: who were
the authors of their own destruction. The altar - Of burnt-offerings,
which was made of wood, but covered with brass before this time, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxvii. 1, 2" id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p25.1" parsed="|Exod|27|1|27|2" osisRef="Bible:Exod.27.1-Exod.27.2">Exod. xxvii, 1, 2</scripRef>, to which this other covering was added for farther
ornament, and security against the fire, continually burning upon it. A
sign - A warning to all strangers to take heed of invading the
priesthood.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p26">40. To him - To Eleazer. These words belong to ver. 38,
the meaning is, that Eleazer did as God bade him.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p27">41. On the morrow - Prodigious wickedness and madness so
soon to forget such a terrible instance of Divine vengeance! The people
of the Lord - So they call those wicked wretches, and rebels against
God! Tho' they were but newly saved from sharing in the same punishment,
and the survivors were as brands plucked out of the burning, yet they
fly in the face of Moses and Aaron, to whose intercession they owe their
preservation.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p28">42. They - Moses and Aaron, who in all their distresses
made God their refuge.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p29">43. Moses and Aaron came - To hear what God, who now
appeared, would say to them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p30">45. They fell upon their faces - To beg mercy for the
people; thus rendering Good for Evil.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p31">46. Incense - Which was a sign of intercession, and was
to be accompanied with it. Go unto the congregation - He went with the
incense, to stir up the people to repentance and prayer, to prevent
their utter ruin. This he might do upon this extraordinary occasion,
having God's command for his warrant, though ordinarily incense was to
be offered only in the tabernacle.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xvii.ii-p32">48. The living - Whereby it may seem that this plague,
like that fire, chap. xi, 1, began in the uttermost parts of the
congregation, and so proceeded destroying one after another in an
orderly manner, which gave Aaron occasion and direction so to place
himself, as a mediator to God on their behalf.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="47.45%" prev="ii.v.xvii.ii" next="ii.v.xviii.i" id="ii.v.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XVII" id="ii.v.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="47.45%" prev="ii.v.xviii" next="ii.v.xviii.ii" id="ii.v.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xviii.i-p1">The blossoming of Aaron's rod, ver. 1-9. It is laid up
for a memorial, ver. 10, 11. The people are terrified, ver. 12, 13.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XVII" progress="47.45%" prev="ii.v.xviii.i" next="ii.v.xix" id="ii.v.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xviii.ii-p1">2. Of every one - Not of every person, but of every
tribe. A rod - That staff, or rod, which the princes carried in their
hands as tokens of their dignity and authority. Every man's name - Every
prince's: for they being the first-born, and the chief of their tribes
might above all others pretend to the priesthood, if it was communicable
to any of their tribes, and besides each prince represented all his
tribe: so that this was a full decision of the question. And this place
seems to confirm, that not only Korah and the Levites, but also those of
other tribes contested with Moses and Aaron about the priesthood, as
that which belonged to all the congregation they being all holy.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xviii.ii-p2">3. Aaron's name - Rather than Levi's, for that would have
left the controversy undecided between Aaron and the other Levites,
whereas this would justify the appropriation of the priesthood to
Aaron's family. One rod - There shall be in this, as there is in all the
other tribes, only one rod, and that for the head of their tribe, who is
Aaron in this tribe: whereas it might have been expected that there
should have been two rods, one for Aaron, and another for his
competitors of the same tribe. But Aaron's name was sufficient to
determine both the tribe, and that branch or family of the tribe, to
whom this dignity should be affixed.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xviii.ii-p3">4. Before the testimony - That is, before the ark of the
testimony, close by the ark. I will meet with you - And manifest my mind
to you, for the ending of this dispute.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xviii.ii-p4">6. Among their rods - Was laid up with the rest, being
either one of the twelve, as the Hebrew affirm, or the thirteenth, as
others think.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xviii.ii-p5">8. Into the tabernacle - Into the most holy place, which
he might safely do under the protection of God's command, though
otherwise none but the high-priest might enter there, and that once in a
year.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xviii.ii-p6">10. To be kept for a token - it is probable, the buds and
blossoms and fruit, all which could never have grown together, but by
miracle, continued fresh, the same which produced them in a night
preserving them for ages.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xviii.ii-p7">12. We perish - Words of consternation, arising from the
remembrance of these severe and repeated judgments, from the threatening
of death upon any succeeding murmurings, and from the sense of their own
guilt and weakness, which made them fear lest they should relapse into
the same miscarriages, and thereby bring the vengeance of God upon
themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xviii.ii-p8">13. Near - Nearer than he should do; an error which we
may easily commit. Will God proceed with us according to his strict
justice, till all the people be cut off?</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="47.49%" prev="ii.v.xviii.ii" next="ii.v.xix.i" id="ii.v.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XVIII" id="ii.v.xix-p0.1" parsed="|Num|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="47.49%" prev="ii.v.xix" next="ii.v.xix.ii" id="ii.v.xix.i">

<p id="ii.v.xix.i-p1">The Work of the priests and Levites, ver. 1-7. The
maintenance of the priests, ver. 8-20. Of the Levites, ver. 21-24. The
portion they are to pay to the priests, ver. 25-32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XVIII" progress="47.50%" prev="ii.v.xix.i" next="ii.v.xx" id="ii.v.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p1">1. Shall bear the iniquity of the sanctuary - Shall
suffer the punishment of all the usurpations, or pollutions of the
sanctuary, or the holy things, by the Levites, or any of the people,
because you have power from me to keep them all within their bounds.
Thus the people are in good measure secured against their fears. Also
they are informed that Aaron's high dignity was attended with great
burdens, having not only his own, but the people's sins to answer for;
and therefore they had no such reason to envy him, if the benefits and
dangers were equally considered. The iniquity of your priesthood - That
is, Of all the errors committed by yourselves, or by you permitted in
others in things, belonging to your priesthood.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p2">2. Unto thee - About sacrifices and offerings and other
things, according to the rules I have prescribed them. The Levites are
said to minister to Aaron here, to the church, chap. xvi, 9, and to God,
<scripRef passage="Deut. x. 8" id="ii.v.xix.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Deut|10|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.10.8">Deut. x, 8</scripRef>. They shall not contend with thee for superiority, as they
have done, but shall be subordinate to thee. Thy sons with thee - Or,
both to thee, and to thy sons with thee: Which translation may seem to
be favoured by the following words, before the tabernacle, which was the
proper place where the Levites ministered. Besides, both the foregoing
words, and the two following verses, entirely speak of the ministry of
the Levites, and the ministry of the priests is distinctly spoken of,
ver. 5.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p3">3. They charge - That is, that which thou shalt command
them and commit unto them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p4">5. The sanctuary - Of the holy, and of the most holy
place.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p5">6. To you they are given as a gift - We are to value it
as a great gift of the divine bounty, to have those joined to us, that
will be helpful and serviceable to us, in the service of God.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p6">7. The altar - Of burnt-offering. Within the veil - This
phrase here comprehends both the holy and the most holy place. As a gift
which I have freely conferred upon you, and upon you alone; and
therefore let no man henceforth dare either to charge you with arrogance
in appropriating this to yourselves, or to invade your office.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p7">8. I have given them - Not only the charge, but the use
of them for thyself and family. By reason of the anointing - That is,
because thou art priest, and art to devote thyself wholly to my
service.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p8">9. Most holy - Such as were to be eaten only by the
priests, and that in the sanctuary. Reserved - That is, such sacrifices
or parts of sacrifices as were not burnt in the fire. Render unto me -
By way of compensation for a trespass committed against me, in which
case a ram was to be offered, which was a most holy thing, and may be
particularly designed here.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p9">10. In the most holy place - In the court of the priests,
where there were places for this use, which is called the most holy
place, not simply and absolutely, but in respect of the thing he speaks
of because this was the most holy of all the places appointed for eating
holy things, whereof some might be eaten in any clean place in the camp,
or in their own house.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p10">13. Whatsoever is first ripe - Not only the first-fruits
of the oil and wine, and wheat now mentioned, but all other first-fruits
of all other grains, and all fruit trees. Clean - And none else, because
these were first offered to God, and by consequence given to priests;
but for those which were immediately given to the priests, the clean and
unclean might eat of them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p11">14. Devoted - Dedicated to God by vow or otherwise,
provided it be such a thing as might be eaten: for the vessels or
treasures of gold and silver which were dedicated by Joshua, David, or
others, were not the priests, but appropriated to the uses of the
temple.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p12">15. Of men - Which were offered to God in his temple, and
to his service and disposal.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p13">16. Those that are to be redeemed - Namely, of men only,
not of unclean beasts, as is manifest from the time and price of
redemption here mentioned, both which agree to men; the time, ver. 16,
the price, chap. iii, 46, 47, but neither agree to unclean beasts, which
were to be redeemed with a sheep, <scripRef passage="Exod. xiii. 13" id="ii.v.xix.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Exod|13|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.13.13">Exod. xiii, 13</scripRef>, and that after it was eight days old.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p14">17. Holy - Namely, in a peculiar manner, consecrated to
an holy use, even to be sacrificed to God. <scripRef passage="Deut. xv. 19" id="ii.v.xix.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Deut|15|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.15.19">Deut. xv, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p15">18. The flesh - All the flesh of them, and not only some
parts, as in other sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p16">19. A covenant of salt - A durable and perpetual
covenant; so called here and <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xiii. 5" id="ii.v.xix.ii-p16.1" parsed="|2Chr|13|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.13.5">2 Chron. xiii, 5</scripRef>, either, because salt is a sign of incorruption, as being of
singular use to preserve things from corruption: or, because it is
ratified on their part by salt, which is therefore called the salt of
the covenant, for which the priests were obliged to take care, that it
should never be lacking from any meat-offering, <scripRef passage="Lev. ii. 13" id="ii.v.xix.ii-p16.2" parsed="|Lev|2|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.2.13">Lev. ii, 13</scripRef>. And this privilege conferred upon the priests is called a
covenant because it is given them conditionally, upon condition of their
service, and care about the worship of God.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p17">20. In their land - In the land of the children of
Israel. You shall not have a distinct portion of land, as the other
tribes shall. The reason of this law, was, partly because God would have
them wholly devoted to his service, and therefore free from worldly
incumbrances; partly, because God had abundantly provided for them
otherwise, by tithes and first-fruits and oblations; and partly that by
this means being dispersed among the several tribes, they might have the
better opportunity for teaching and watching over the people. I am thy
part - I have appointed thee a liberal maintenance out of my
oblations.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p18">21. The tenth - For the tithes were all given to the
Levites, and out of their tithes the tenth was given to the priests.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p19">22. Nigh - So nigh as to do any proper act to the priests
or Levites.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p20">23. Their iniquity - The punishment due not only for
their own, but also for the people's miscarriage, if it be committed
through their connivance or negligence. And this was the reason why the
priests withstood King Uzziah, when he would have burnt incense to the
Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p21">24. An heave-offering - An acknowledgment that they have
all their land and the fruits of it from God's bounty. Note the word
heave-offering, which is for the most part understood of a particular
kind of offerings heaved or lifted up to the Lord, is here used for any
offering.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p22">26. Ye shall offer up an heave-offering - They who are
employed in assisting the devotions of others, must be sure to pay their
own as an heave-offering. Prayers and praises, or rather the heart
lifted up in them, are now our heave-offerings.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p23">27. As though it were the corn - It shall be accepted of
you as much as if you offered it out of your own lands and labours.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p24">28. To Aaron - And to his children, who were all to have
their share herein.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p25">29. Your gifts - Not only out of your tithes, but out of
the other gifts which you receive from the people, and out of those
fields which shall belong to your cities. Offer - To the priest. As many
gifts, so many heave-offerings; you shall reserve a part out of each of
them for the priest. The hallowed part - the tenth part, which was the
part or proportion that God hallowed or sanctified to himself as his
proper portion.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p26">31. Every place - In every clean place, and not in the
holy place only.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xix.ii-p27">32. Neither shall ye pollute the holy things - As you
will do, if you abuse their holy offerings, by reserving that entirely
to yourselves, which they offer to God to be disposed as he hath
appointed, namely, part to you, and part to the priests.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="47.63%" prev="ii.v.xix.ii" next="ii.v.xx.i" id="ii.v.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XIX" id="ii.v.xx-p0.1" parsed="|Num|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="47.63%" prev="ii.v.xx" next="ii.v.xx.ii" id="ii.v.xx.i">

<p id="ii.v.xx.i-p1">The manner of preparing the water of purification, ver.
1-10. Of using it, ver. 11-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XIX" progress="47.63%" prev="ii.v.xx.i" next="ii.v.xxi" id="ii.v.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p1">2. Red - A fit colour to shadow forth the bloody nature
of sin, and the blood of Christ, from which this water and all other
rites had their purifying virtue. No blemish - A fit type of Christ.
Upon which never came yoke - Whereby may be signified, either that
Christ in himself was free from all the yoke or obligation of God's
command, till for our sakes he put himself under the law; or that Christ
was not forced to undertake our burden and cross, but did voluntarily
chuse it. He was bound and held with no other cords but those of his own
love.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p2">3. Eleazar - Who was the second priest, and in some
cases, the deputy of the high-priest. To him, not to Aaron, because this
service made him unclean for a season, and consequently unfit for holy
ministrations, whereas the high-priest was, as far as possibly he could,
to be preserved from all sorts of defilement, fit for his high and holy
work. Without the camp -Partly because it was reputed an unclean and
accursed thing, being laden with the sins of all the people; and partly
to signify that Christ should suffer without the camp, in the place
where malefactors suffered.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p3">4. Before the tabernacle - Or, towards the tabernacle,
standing at a good distance from it, even without the camp, yet turning
and looking towards it. For here is no intimation that he went into the
camp before this work was done, but rather the contrary is implied, ver.
7. And because being defiled by this work he could not come near the
tabernacle, it was sufficient for him to turn and look towards it. This
signified his presenting this blood before the Lord by way of atonement
for his and the people's sins, and his expectation of acceptance and
pardon only from God, and from his mercy-seat in the tabernacle. And
this typified the satisfaction that was made to God, by the death of
Christ, who by the eternal Spirit offered himself without spot to God,
and did as it were sprinkle his own blood before the sanctuary, when he
said, Into thy hands I commend my spirit!</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p4">5. Burn the heifer - To signify the sharp and grievous
sufferings of Christ for our sins. Her blood - All of it, but what was
spent in sprinkling.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p5">6. Cedar-wood, hyssop, scarlet - All which are here
burnt, and as it were offered to God, that they might be sanctified to
this holy use for the future; for of these kinds of things was the
sprinkle made wherewith the unclean were sprinkled, <scripRef passage="Lev. xiv. 4" id="ii.v.xx.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Lev|14|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.14.4">Lev. xiv, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p6">7. Shall be unclean - Partly to teach us the imperfection
of the Levitical priesthood, in which the priest himself was defiled by
some parts of his work, and partly to shew that Christ himself, though
he had no sin of his own, yet was reputed by men, and judged by God, as
a sinful person, by reason of our sins which were laid upon him.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p7">9. For a water - Or, to the water, that is, to be put to
the water, or mixed with it. Of separation - Appointed for the cleansing
of them that are in a state of separation, who for their uncleanness are
separated from the congregation. It is a purification for sin - Hebrew.
a sin, that is, an offering for sin, or rather a mean for expiation or
cleansing of sin. And this was a type of that purification for sin,
which our Lord Jesus made by his death.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p8">10. The stranger - A proselyte.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p9">12. With it - With the water of separation. On the third
day - To typify Christ's resurrection on that day by which we are
cleansed or sanctified.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p10">13. Whosoever toucheth - If this transgression be done
presumptuously; for if it was done ignorantly, he was only to offer
sacrifice. Defiled -By approaching to it in his uncleanness: for holy
things or places were ceremonially defiled with the touch of any unclean
person or thing. Is upon him - He continues in his guilt, not now to be
washed away by this water, but to be punished by cutting off.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p11">16. With a sword - Or by any other violent way.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p12">17. Running water - Waters flowing from a spring or
river, which are the purest. These manifestly signify God's spirit,
which is oft compared to water, and by which alone true purification is
obtained. Those who promise themselves benefit by the righteousness of
Christ, while they submit not to the influence of his spirit, do but
deceive themselves; for they cannot be purified by the ashes, otherwise
than in the running water.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p13">20. That shall not purify himself - Shall contemptuously
refuse to submit to this way of purification.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p14">21. Shall wash his clothes - Because he is unclean. It is
strange, that the same water should cleanse one person, and defile
another. But God would have it so, to teach us that it did not cleanse
by any virtue in itself, or in the work done, but only by virtue of
God's appointment: to mind the laws of the imperfection of their
priesthood, and their ritual purifications and expiations, and
consequently of the necessity of a better priest and sacrifice and way
of purifying; and to shew that the efficacy of God's ordinances doth not
depend upon the person or quality of his ministers, because the same
person who, was polluted himself could and did cleanse others. He that
toucheth the water - Either by sprinkling of it, or by being sprinkled
with it; for even he that was cleansed by it, was not fully cleansed as
soon as he was sprinkled, but only at the even of that day.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xx.ii-p15">22. The unclean person - Not he who is so only by
touching the water of separation, ver. 21, but he who is so by the
greater sort of uncleanness, which lasted seven days, and which was not
removed without the use of this water of purification.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="47.73%" prev="ii.v.xx.ii" next="ii.v.xxi.i" id="ii.v.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XX" id="ii.v.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|Num|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="47.73%" prev="ii.v.xxi" next="ii.v.xxi.ii" id="ii.v.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxi.i-p1">This chapter begins the history of the fortieth year of
the Israelites wandering in the wilderness. Little is recorded of them
from the beginning of their second year till this, which brought them to
the borders of Canaan. Here is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.xxi.i-p2">1. The death of Miriam, ver. 1.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.xxi.i-p3">2. The fetching water out of the rock, ver.
2-13.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.xxi.i-p4">3. The treaty with the Edomites, ver.
14-21.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.xxi.i-p5">4. The death of Aaron and installment of
Eleazar, ver. 22-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XX" progress="47.73%" prev="ii.v.xxi.i" next="ii.v.xxii" id="ii.v.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p1">1. Then - To wit, after many stations and long journeys
here omitted, but particularly described, chap. xxxiii, 1-49. Zin - A
place near the land of Edom, distinct and distant from that Sin, <scripRef passage="Exod. xvi. 1" id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|16|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.16.1">Exod. xvi, 1</scripRef>. The first month - Of the fortieth year, as is evident,
because the next station to this was in mount Hor, where Aaron died, who
died in the fifth month of the fortieth year, chap. xxxiii, 38. Moses
doth not give us an exact journal of all occurrences in the wilderness,
but only of those which were most remarkable, and especially of those
which happened in the first and second, and in the fortieth year. Miriam
died - Four months before Aaron, and but a few more before Moses.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p2">2. No water - Which having followed them through all
their former journeys, began to fail them here, because they were now
come near countries, where waters might be had by ordinary means, and
therefore God would not use extraordinary, lest he should seem to
prostitute the honour of miracles. This story, though like that, <scripRef passage="Exod. xvii. 1-7" id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Exod|17|1|17|7" osisRef="Bible:Exod.17.1-Exod.17.7">Exod. xvii, 1-7</scripRef>, is different from it, as appears by divers circumstances.
It is a great mercy, to have plenty of water; a mercy which if we found
the want of, we should own the worth of.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p3">3. Before the Lord - Suddenly, rather than to die such a
lingering death. Their sin was much greater than that of their parents,
because they should have taken warning by their miscarriages, and by the
terrible effects of them, which their eyes had seen.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p4">8. The rod - That which was laid up before the Lord in
the tabernacle; whether it was Aaron's rod, which was laid up there,
chap. xvii, 10, or Moses's rod by which he wrought so many miracles. For
it is likely, that wonder-working rod, was laid up in some part of the
tabernacle, though not in or near the ark, where Aaron's blossoming rod
was put.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p5">9. From before the Lord - Out of the tabernacle.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p6">12. Ye believed me not - But shewed your infidelity:
which they did, either by smiting the rock, and that twice, which is
emphatically noted, as if he doubted whether once smiting would have
done it, whereas he was not commanded to smite so much as once, but only
to speak to it: or by the doubtfulness of these words, chap. xx, 10.
Must we fetch water out of the rock? which implies a suspicion of it,
whereas they should have spoken positively and confidently to the rock
to give forth water. And yet they did not doubt of the power of God, but
of his will, whether he would gratify these rebels with this farther
miracle, after so many of the like kind. To sanctify me - To give me the
glory of my power in doing this miracle, and of my truth in punctually
fulfilling my promise, and of my goodness in doing it notwithstanding
the peoples perverseness. In the eyes of Israel - This made their sin
scandalous to the Israelites, who of themselves were too prone to
infidelity; to prevent the contagion, God leaves a monument of his
displeasure upon them, and inflicts a punishment as publick as their
sin.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p7">13. Meribah - That is, strife. In them - Or, among them,
the children of Israel, by the demonstration of his omnipotency,
veracity, and clemency towards the Israelites, and of his impartial
holiness and severity against sin even in his greatest friends and
favourites.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p8">14. All the travel - All the wanderings and afflictions
of our parents and of us their children, which doubtless have come to
thine ears.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p9">16. An Angel - The Angel of the Covenant, who first
appeared to Moses in the bush, and afterward in the cloudy pillar, who
conducted Moses and the people out of Egypt, and through the wilderness.
For though Moses may be called an angel or messenger yet it is not
probable that he is meant, partly because Moses was the person that sent
this message; and partly because another angel above Moses conducted
them, and the mention hereof to the Edomites, was likely to give more
authority to their present message. In Kadesh - Near, the particle in
being so often used.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p10">17. The wells - Or, pits, which any of you have digged
for your private use, not without paying for it, ver. 19, but only of
the waters of common rivers, which are free to all passengers. No man's
property ought to be invaded, under colour of religion. Dominion is
founded in providence, not in Grace.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p11">18. By me - Through my country: I will not suffer thee to
do so: which was an act of policy, to secure themselves from so numerous
an host.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p12">19. Said - That is, their messengers replied what here
follows.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p13">23. And the Lord spake unto Moses and Aaron - So these
two dear brothers must part! Aaron must die first: but Moses is not
likely to be long after him. So that it is only for a while, a little
while, that they are separated.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p14">24. Because they rebelled - This was one but not the only
reason. God would not have Moses and Aaron to carry the people into
Canaan, for this reason also, to signify the insufficiency of the
Mosaical law and Aaronical priesthood to make them perfectly happy, and
the necessity of a better, and to keep the Israelites from resting in
them, so as to be taken off from their expectation of Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p15">26. His garments - His priestly garments, in token of his
resignation of his office. Put them on Eleazar - By way of admission and
inauguration to his office.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p16">27. In the sight of all the congregation - That their
hearts might be more affected with their loss of so great a pillar, and
that they all might be witnesses of the translation of the priesthood
from Aaron to Eleazar.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p17">28. And Moses stript Aaron - And Death will strip us.
Naked we came into the world: naked we must go out. We shall see little
reason to be proud of our cloaths, our ornaments, or marks of honour, if
we consider how soon death will strip us of all our glory, and take the
crown off from our head! Aaron died there - He died in Mosera, <scripRef passage="Deut. x. 6" id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Deut|10|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.10.6">Deut. x, 6</scripRef>. Mosera was the general name of the place where that station
was, and mount Hor a particular place in it. Presently after he was
stript of his priestly garments, he laid him down and died. A good man
would desire, if it were the will of God, not to outlive his usefulness.
Why should we covet to continue any longer in this world, than while we
may do God and our generation some service?</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxi.ii-p18">29. Saw - Understood by the relation of Moses and
Eleazar, and by other signs. Thirty days - The time of publick and
solemn mourning for great persons.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="47.85%" prev="ii.v.xxi.ii" next="ii.v.xxii.i" id="ii.v.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXI" id="ii.v.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="47.85%" prev="ii.v.xxii" next="ii.v.xxii.ii" id="ii.v.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxii.i-p1">The defect of Arad, ver. 1-3. The people murmur and are
plagued with fiery serpents, ver. 4-6. They are healed by looking on the
brazen serpent, ver. 7-9. They journey forward, ver. 10-20. Conquer
Sihon, ver. 21-31. And Og, ver. 33-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXI" progress="47.85%" prev="ii.v.xxii.i" next="ii.v.xxiii" id="ii.v.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p1">1. King Arad - Or rather, the Canaanite King of Arad: for
Arad is not the name of a man, but of a city or territory. And he seems
to be called a Canaanite in a general sense, as the Amorites and others.
The south - Of Canaan, towards the east, and near the dead sea. Of the
spies - Not of those spies which Moses sent to spy the land, for that
was done thirty eight years before this, and they went so privately,
that the Canaanites took no notice of them, nor knew which way they came
or went; but of the spies which he himself sent out to observe the
marches and motions of the Israelites. Took some of them prisoners -
Which God permitted for Israel's humiliation, and to teach them not to
expect the conquest of that land from their own wisdom or valour.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p2">2. I will utterly destroy them - I will reserve no person
or thing for my own use, but devote them all to total destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p3">3. They utterly destroyed them - Neither Moses nor the
whole body of the people did this but a select number sent out to punish
that king and people, who were so fierce and malicious that they came
out of their own country to fight with the Israelites in the wilderness;
and these, when they had done this work, returned to their brethren into
the wilderness. But why did they not all now go into Canaan, and pursue
this victory? Because God would not permit it, there being several works
yet to be done, other people must be conquered, the Israelites must be
farther humbled and tried and purged, Moses must die, and then they
shall enter, and that in a more glorious manner, even over Jordan, which
shall be miraculously dried up, to give them passage. Hormah - That is,
utter destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p4">4. By way of the Red-sea - Which leadeth to the Red-sea,
as they must needs do to compass the land of Edom. Because of the way -
By reason of this journey, which was long and troublesome, and
unexpected, because the successful entrance and victorious progress
which some of them had made in the borders of Canaan, made them think
they might have speedily gone in and taken possession of it, and so have
saved the tedious travels and farther difficulties, into which Moses had
again brought them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p5">5. Against God - Against Christ, their chief conductor,
whom they tempted, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. x. 19" id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|1Cor|10|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10.19">1 Cor. x, 19</scripRef>. Thus contemptuously did they speak of Manna, whereas it
appears it yielded excellent nourishment, because in the strength of it
they were able to go so many and such tedious journeys.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p6">6. Fiery serpents - There were many such in this
wilderness, which having been hitherto restrained by God, are now let
loose and sent among them. They are called fiery from their effects,
because their poison caused an intolerable heat and burning and thirst,
which was aggravated with this circumstance of the place, that here was
no water, ver. 5.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p7">8. A fiery serpent - That is, the figure of a serpent in
brass, which is of a fiery colour. This would require some time: God
would not speedily take off the judgment, because he saw they were not
throughly humbled. Upon a pole - That the people might see it from all
parts of the camp, and therefore the pole must be high, and the serpent
large. When he looketh -This method of cure was prescribed, that it
might appear to be God's own work, and not the effect of nature or art:
and that it might be an eminent type of our salvation by Christ. The
serpent signified Christ, who was in the likeness of sinful flesh,
though without sin, as this brazen serpent had the outward shape, but
not the inward poison, of the other serpents: the pole resembled the
cross upon which Christ was lifted up for our salvation: and looking up
to it designed our believing in Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p8">9. He lived - He was delivered from death, and cured of
his disease.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p9">10. In Oboth - Not immediately, but after two other
stations mentioned, chap. xxxiii, 43, 44.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p10">12. The valley of Zared - Or rather, by the brook of
Zared, which ran into the dead sea.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p11">13. On the other side - Or rather, on this side of Arnon,
for so it now was to the Israelites, who had not yet passed over it.
Between Moab and the Amorites - Though formerly it and the land beyond
it belonged to Moab, yet afterwards it had been taken from them by
Sihon. This is added to reconcile two seemingly contrary commands of
God, the one that of not meddling with the land of the Moabites, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 9" id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Deut|2|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.9">Deut. ii, 9</scripRef>, the other that of going over Arnon and taking possession of
the land beyond it, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 24" id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p11.2" parsed="|Deut|2|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.24">Deut. ii, 24</scripRef>, because, saith he, it is not now the land of the Moabites,
but of the Amorites.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p12">14. The book of the wars of the Lord - This seems to have
been some poem or narration of the wars and victories of the Lord,
either by: or relating to the Israelites: which may be asserted without
any prejudice to the integrity of the holy scripture, because this book
doth not appear to have been written by a prophet, er to be designed for
a part of the canon, which yet Moses might quote, as St. Paul doth some
of the heathen poets. And as St. Luke assures us, that many did write an
history of the things done, and said by Christ, <scripRef passage="Luke i. 1" id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Luke|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1.1">Luke i, 1</scripRef>, whose writings were never received as canonical, the like
may be conceived concerning this and some few other books mentioned in
the old testament. The brooks - The brook, the plural number for the
singular, as the plural number rivers is used concerning Jordan, <scripRef passage="Psalm 7" id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p12.2" parsed="|Ps|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.7">Psalm
7</scripRef>iv, 15, and concerning Tigris, <scripRef passage="Nahum ii. 6" id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p12.3" parsed="|Nah|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Nah.2.6">Nahum ii, 6</scripRef>, and concerning Euphrates, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p12.4" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xxxvii, 1, all which may
be to called because of the several little streams into which they were
divided.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p13">15. Ar - A chief city in Moab.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p14">16. Beer - This place and Mattanah, Nahaliel, and Bamoth
named here, ver. 19, are not mentioned among those places where they
pitched or encamped, chap. xxxiii, 1-49. Probably they did not pitch or
encamp in these places, but only pass by or through them. I will give
them water - In a miraculous manner. Before they prayed, God granted,
and prevented them with the blessings of goodness. And as the brasen
serpent was the figure of Christ, so is this well a figure of the
spirit, who is poured forth for our comfort, and from him flow rivers of
living waters.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p15">17. Spring up - Hebrew. ascend, that is, let thy waters,
which now lie hid below in the earth, ascend for our use. It is either a
prediction that it should spring up, or a prayer that it might.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p16">18. With their staves - Probably as Moses smote the rock
with his rod, so they struck the earth with their staves, as a sign that
God would cause the water to flow out of the earth where they smote it,
as he did before out of the rock. Perhaps they made holes with their
staves in the sandy ground, and God caused the water immediately to
spring up.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p17">20. Pisgah - This was the top of those high hills of
Abarim.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p18">21. Sent messengers - By God's allowance, that so Sihon's
malice might be the more evident and inexcusable, and their title to his
country more clear in the judgment of all men, as being gotten by a just
war, into which they were forced for their own defense.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p19">22. Let me pass - They spoke what they seriously intended
and would have done, if he had given them quiet passage.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p20">24. From Arnon - Or, which reached from Arnon; and so
here is a description or limitation of Sihon's conquest and kingdom,
that is, extended only from Arnon, unto the children of Ammon; and then
the following words, for the border of the children of Ammon was strong,
come in very fitly, not as a reason why the Israelites did not conquer
the Ammonites, for they were absolutely forbidden to meddle with them, <scripRef passage="Deut. iii. 8" id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p20.1" parsed="|Deut|3|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.3.8">Deut. iii, 8</scripRef>, but as a reason why Sihon could not enlarge his conquests
to the Ammonites, as he had done to the Moabites. Jabbok - A river by
which the countries of Ammon and Moab were in part bounded and divided.
Strong - Either by the advantage of the river, or by their strong holds
in their frontiers.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p21">26. Was the city of Sihon - This is added as a reason why
Israel took possession of this land, because it was not now the land of
the Moabites, but in the possession of the Amorites. The former king
-The predecessor of Balak, who was the present king. See the wisdom of
providence, which prepares long before, for the accomplishing God's
purposes in their season! This country being designed for Israel, is
before-hand put into the hand of the Amorites, who little think they
have it but as trustees, till Israel comes of age. We understand not the
vast reaches of providence: but known unto God are all his works!</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p22">27. In Proverbs - The poets or other ingenious persons,
of the Amorites or Canaanites, who made this following song of triumph
over the vanquished Moabites: which is here brought in, as a proof that
this was now Sihon's land, and as an evidence of the just judgment of
God in spoiling the spoilers, and subduing those who insulted over their
conquered enemies. Come into Heshbon - These are the words either of
Sihon speaking to his people, or of the people exhorting one another to
come and possess the city which they had taken. Of Sihon - That which
once was the royal city of the king of Moab, but now is the city of
Sihon.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p23">28. A fire - The fury of war, which is fitly compared to
fire. Out of Heshbon - That city which before was a refuge and defense
to all the country, now is turned into a great annoyance. It hath
consumed Ar -This may be understood not of the city Ar, but of the
people or the country subject or belonging to that great and royal city.
The lords of the high places - The princes or governors of the strong
holds, which were frequently in high places, especially in that
mountainous country, and which were in divers parts all along the river
Arnon. So the Amorites triumphed over the vanquished Moabites. But the
triumphing of the wicked is short!</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p24">29. People of Chemosh - The worshippers of Chemosh: so
the God of the Moabites was called. He, that is, their God, hath
delivered up his own people to his and their enemies; nor could he
secure even those that had escaped the sword, but suffered them to be
carried into captivity. The words of this and the following verse seem
to be not a part of that triumphant song made, by some Amoritish poet,
which seems to be concluded, ver. 28, but of the Israelites making their
observation upon it. And here they scoff at the impotency not only of
the Moabites, but of their God also, who could not save his people from
the sword of Sihon and the Amorites.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p25">30. Though you feeble Moabites, and your God too, could
not resist Sihon, we Israelites, by the help of our God, have shot, with
success and victory, at them, at Sihon and his Amorites. Heshbon - The
royal city of Sihon, and by him lately repaired, Is perished - Is taken
away from Sihon, and so is all his country, even as far as Dibon.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p26">32. Jaazer - One of the cities of Moab formerly taken
from them by Sihon, and now taken from him by the Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxii.ii-p27">33. Og - Who also was a king of the Amorites. And it may
seem that Sihon and Og were the leaders or captains of two great
colonies which came out of Canaan, and drove out the former inhabitants
of these places. Bashan - A rich country, famous for its pastures and
breed of cattle, and for its oaks.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="48.05%" prev="ii.v.xxii.ii" next="ii.v.xxiii.i" id="ii.v.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXII" id="ii.v.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="48.05%" prev="ii.v.xxiii" next="ii.v.xxiii.ii" id="ii.v.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.i-p1">Balak's fear of Israel, ver. 1-4. His message to Balaam,
who refuses to come, ver. 5-14. On the second message he goes, ver.
15-21. He is rebuked by an angel, ver. 22-35. His interview with Balak,
ver. 36-41.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXII" progress="48.05%" prev="ii.v.xxiii.i" next="ii.v.xxiv" id="ii.v.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p1">1. The plains of Moab - Which still retained their
ancient title, though they had been taken away from the Moabites by
Sihon, and from him by the Israelites. By Jericho - That is, over
against Jericho.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p2">3. Sore afraid - As it was foretold both in general of
all nations, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 25" id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Deut|2|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.25">Deut. ii, 25</scripRef>, and particularly concerning Moab, <scripRef passage="Exod. xv. 15" id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Exod|15|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.15.15">Exod. xv, 15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p3">4. The elders - Called the kings of Midian, chap. xxxi,
8, and princes of Midian, <scripRef passage="Josh. xiii. 21" id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Josh|13|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.13.21">Josh. xiii, 21</scripRef>, who though divided into their kingdoms yet were now united
upon the approach of the Israelites their common enemy, and being, as it
seems, a potent and crafty people, and neighbours to the Moabites, these
seek confederacy with them. We read of Midianites near Mount Sinai,
Exod. ii, and iii, which seem to have been a colony of this people, that
went out to seek new quarters, as the manner of those times was, but the
body of that people were seated in those parts. Lick up - That is,
consume and utterly destroy, in which sense the fire is said to lick up
the water and sacrifices, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xviii. 38" id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p3.2" parsed="|1Kgs|18|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.18.38">1 Kings xviii, 38</scripRef>. All that are round about us - All our people, who live in
the country adjoining to each city, where the princes reside.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p4">5. Balaam - Who is called a prophet, <scripRef passage="2Pet ii. 16" id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|2Pet|2|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.2.16">2Pet ii, 16</scripRef>, because God was pleased to inspire and direct him to speak
the following prophecies. Indeed many of the Jewish writers say, that
Balaam had been a great prophet, who for the accomplishment of his
predictions, and the answers of his prayers, had been looked upon justly
as a man of great interest with God. However it is certain, that
afterwards for his covetousness, God departed from him. Beor - Or,
Bosor, <scripRef passage="2Pet ii. 15" id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p4.2" parsed="|2Pet|2|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Pet.2.15">2Pet ii, 15</scripRef>, for he had two names, as many others had. Pethor - A city
in Mesopotamia. By the river - By Euphrates, which is called the river,
by way of eminency, and here the river of Balaam's land or country, to
wit, of Mesopotamia.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p5">6. Curse them for my sake and benefit; use thy utmost
power, which thou hast with thy Gods, to blast and ruin them. We may
smite them - Thou by thy imprecations, and I by my sword.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p6">8. This night - The night was the time when God used to
reveal his mind by dreams. The Lord - Hebrew. Jehovah, the true God,
whom he here mentions, either for his own greater reputation, as if he
consulted not with inferior spirits, but with the supreme God; or rather
because this was Israel's God, and the only possible way of ruining them
was by engaging their God against them: as the Roman and other Heathens,
when they went to besiege any city, used enchantments to call forth that
God under whose peculiar protection they were. Of Moab - And of Midian
too.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p7">9. What men are these - He asks this that Balaam by
repeating the thing in God's presence might be convinced and ashamed of
his sin and folly, in offering his service in such a business: and for a
foundation to the following answer.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p8">20. If the men come - On this condition he was to go.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p9">22. Because he went - Because he went of his own accord,
with the princes of Moab, and did not wait till they came to call him,
which was the sign and condition of God's permission, but rather himself
rose and called them. The apostle describes Balaam's sin here to be,
that he ran greedily into an error for reward, <scripRef passage="Jude i. 11" id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Jude|1|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.1.11">Jude i, 11</scripRef>. For an adversary - To oppose, if not to kill him. His
servants with him - The rest of the company being probably gone before
them. For in those ancient times there was more of simplicity, and less
of ceremony, and therefore it is not strange that Balaam came at some
distance, after the rest, and attended only by his own servants.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p10">28. Opened the mouth - Conferred upon her the power of
speech and reasoning for that time.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p11">29. Balaam said - Balaam was not much terrified with the
ass's speaking, because perhaps he was accustomed to converse with evil
spirits, who appeared to him and discoursed with him in the shape of
such creatures. Perhaps he was so blinded by passion, that he did not
consider the strangeness of the thing.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p12">31. On his face - In token of reverence and
submission.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p13">32. Thy way is perverse - Springing from
covetousness.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p14">33. I had slain thee - I had slain thee alone, and not
her, therefore her turning aside and falling down was wholly for thy
benefit, not for her own, and thy anger against her was unjust and
unreasonable.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p15">35. Go with the men - I allow thee to go, upon the
following terms.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p16">36. In the utmost coast - Not far from the camp of the
Israelites, whom he desired him to curse.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p17">40. The princes - Whom the king had left to attend
him.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiii.ii-p18">41. The high places of Baal - Consecrated to the worship
of Baal, that is, of Baal Peor, who was their Baal or God. The utmost
part - That is, all that people, even to the utmost and remotest of
them, as appears by comparing this with, chap. xxiii, 13. He hoped that
the sight of such a numerous host ready to break in upon his country
would stir up his passion.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="48.14%" prev="ii.v.xxiii.ii" next="ii.v.xxiv.i" id="ii.v.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXIII" id="ii.v.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Num|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxiv-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="48.14%" prev="ii.v.xxiv" next="ii.v.xxiv.ii" id="ii.v.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.i-p1">Balaam's first attempt to curse Israel, turned into a
blessing, ver. 1-10. His second attempt with like success, ver. 11-24.
The preparation for a third attempt, ver. 25-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXIII" progress="48.14%" prev="ii.v.xxiv.i" next="ii.v.xxv" id="ii.v.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p1">1. Build seven altars - To the true God, otherwise he
would not have mentioned it to God, as an argument why he should grant
his requests, as he doth, ver. 4. And though Balak was averse from God
and his worship, yet he would be easily overruled by Balaam, who
doubtless told him that it was in vain to make an address to any other
than the God of Israel, who alone was able either to bless or curse them
as he pleased. Seven - This being the solemn and usual number in
sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p2">3. Stand by thy burnt-offering - As in God's presence, as
one that offers thyself as well as thy sacrifices to obtain his favour.
I will go - To some solitary and convenient place, where I may prevail
with God to appear to me. Sheweth me - Reveals to me, either by word or
sign. An high place - Or, into the plain, as that word properly
signifies.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p3">7. His parable - That is, his oracular and prophetical
speech; which he calls a parable, because of the weightiness of the
matter, and the liveliness of the expressions which is usual in
parables. Jacob - The posterity of Jacob.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p4">9. The rocks - Upon which I now stand. I see him - I see
the people, according to thy desire, ver. 41, but cannot improve that
sight to the end for which thou didst design it, to curse them. The
people shall dwell alone - This people are of a distinct kind from
others, God's peculiar people, separated from all other nations, as in
religion and laws, so also in divine protection; and therefore
enchantments cannot have that power against them which they have against
other persons and people.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p5">10. The dust - The numberless people of Jacob or Israel,
who according to God's promise, are now become as the dust of the earth.
Of the righteous - Of this righteous and holy people. The sense is, they
are not only happy above other nations in this life, and therefore in
vain should I curse them, but they have this peculiar privilege, that
they are happy after death: their happiness begins where the happiness
of other people ends; and therefore I heartily wish that my soul may
have its portion with theirs when I die. Was not God now again striving
with him, not only for the sake of Israel, but of his own soul?</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p6">12. Must I not - Ought I not? Is it not my duty? Canst
thou blame me for it?</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p7">13. Thou shalt not see them all - Perhaps he thought the
sight of all them might discourage him, or as it did before, raise his
fancy to an admiration of the multitude and felicity of the people.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p8">15. While I meet the Lord - To consult him, and to
receive an answer from him.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p9">18. Rise up - This word implies the diligent attention
required; rouse up thyself and carefully mind what I say.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p10">19. That he should lie - Break his promises made to his
people for their preservation and benediction. Repent - Change his
counsels or purposes; unless he see iniquity in Jacob.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p11">21. Iniquity - Not such as in the Canaanites: Such as he
will punish with a curse, with utter destruction. The Lord is with him -
He hath a favour for this people, and will defend and save them. The
shout of a king - That is, such joyful and triumphant shouts as those
wherewith a people congratulate the approach and presence of their King:
when he appears among them upon some solemn occasion, or when he returns
from battle with victory. This expression implies God's being their King
and ruler, and their abundant security and confidence in him.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p12">22. Out of Egypt - Namely, by a strong hand, and in spite
of all their enemies, and therefore it is in vain to seek or hope to
overcome them. He - Israel, whom God brought out of Egypt, such change
of numbers being very common in the Hebrew language. The sense is,
Israel is not now what he was in Egypt, a poor, weak, dispirited,
unarmed people, but high and strong and invincible. An unicorn - The
word may mean either a rhinoceros, or a strong and fierce kind of wild
goat. But such a creature as an unicorn, as commonly painted, has no
existence in nature.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p13">23. Against Jacob - Nor against any that truly believe in
Christ. What hath God wrought - How wonderful and glorious are those
works which God is now about to do for Israel! These things will be a
matter of discourse and admiration to all ages.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p14">24. As a great Lion - As a lion rouseth up himself to
fight, or to go out to the prey, so shall Israel stir up themselves to
warlike attempts against their enemies. He shall not lie down - Not rest
or cease from fighting and pursuing.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p15">28. Peor - An high place called Beth-peor, <scripRef passage="Deut. iii. 29" id="ii.v.xxiv.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Deut|3|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.3.29">Deut. iii, 29</scripRef>. That is, the house or temple of Peor, because there they
worshipped Baal- peor.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="48.22%" prev="ii.v.xxiv.ii" next="ii.v.xxv.i" id="ii.v.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXIV" id="ii.v.xxv-p0.1" parsed="|Num|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIV" progress="48.22%" prev="ii.v.xxv" next="ii.v.xxv.ii" id="ii.v.xxv.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxv.i-p1">Balaam inspired by God, blesses Israel again, ver. 1-9.
Answers Balak's reproof, ver. 10-13. Utters several prophecies, ver.
14-24 Goes home, ver. 25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXIV" progress="48.22%" prev="ii.v.xxv.i" next="ii.v.xxvi" id="ii.v.xxv.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p1">1. At other times - In former times. Toward the
wilderness - Where Israel lay encamped, expecting what God of his own
accord would suggest to him concerning this matter.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p2">2. Came upon him - Inspired him to speak the following
words.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p3">3. Whose eyes are open - Hebrew. Who had his eyes shut,
but now open. The eyes of his mind, which God had opened in a peculiar
and prophetical manner, whence prophets are called Seers, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. ix. 9" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p3.1" parsed="|1Sam|9|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.9.9">1 Sam. ix, 9</scripRef>. It implies that before he was blind and stupid, having
eyes, but not seeing nor understanding.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p4">4. The vision - So called properly, because he was awake
when this was revealed to him: A trance - Or, extasy, fainting and
falling upon the ground, as the prophets used to do.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p5">6. As the valleys - Which often from a small beginning
are spread forth far and wide. As gardens - Pleasant and fruitful and
secured by a fence. As lign-aloes - An Arabian and Indian tree of a
sweet smell, yielding shade and shelter both to man and beast; such is
Israel, not only safe themselves, but yielding shelter to all that join
themselves to them. Which the Lord hath planted - Nature, not art.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p6">7. He shall pour the water - That is. God will abundantly
water the valleys, gardens, and trees, which represent the Israelites;
he will wonderfully bless his people, not only with outward blessings,
of which a chief one in those parts was plenty of water, but also with
higher gifts and graces, with his word and spirit, which are often
signified by water, and at last with eternal life, the contemplation
whereof made Balaam desire to die the death of the righteous. His seed
shall be in many waters - This also may be literally understood of their
seed, which shall be sown in waterish ground, and therefore bring forth
a better increase. His King - That is, the King of Israel, or their
chief governor. Than Agag - Than the King of the Amalekites, which King
and people were famous and potent in that age, as may be guessed by
their bold attempt upon so numerous a people as Israel. And it is
probable, that Agag was the common name of the Amalekitish Kings, as
Abimelech was of the Philistines, and Pharaoh of the Egyptians, and
Caesar of the Romans.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p7">9. He lay down - Having conquered his enemies the
Canaanites, and their land, he shall quietly rest and settle himself
there.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p8">11. The Lord - Whose commands thou hast preferred before
my desires and interest; and therefore seek thy recompence from him, and
not from me.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p9">17. I shall see him - Or, I have seen, or do see the
star, and scepter as it here follows, that is, a great and eminent
prince, which was to come out of Israel's loins, the Messiah, as both
Jewish and Christian interpreters expound it, who most eminently and
fully performed what is here said, in destroying the enemies of Israel
or of God's church, here described under the names of the nearest and
fiercest enemies of Israel: And to him alone agrees the foregoing verb
properly, I shall see him, in my own person, as every eye shall see him,
when he comes to judgment. Not now - Not yet, but after many ages. A
star - A title often given to, princes and eminent persons, and
particularly to the Messiah, <scripRef passage="Rev. ii. 28" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Rev|2|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.2.28">Rev. ii, 28</scripRef>; xxii, 16. A scepter - That is, a scepter-bearer, a king or
ruler, even that scepter mentioned <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 10" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p9.2" parsed="|Gen|49|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.10">Gen. xlix, 10</scripRef>. The corners - The borders, which are often used in
scripture for the whole country to which they belong. Of Sheth - This
seems to be the name of some then eminent, though now unknown place or
prince in Moab; there being innumerable instances of such places or
persons sometime famous, but now utterly lost as to all monuments and
remembrances of them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p10">18. A possession - Which was also foretold, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxv. 23" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Gen|25|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.25.23">Gen. xxv, 23</scripRef>, and in part fulfilled, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. viii. 14" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p10.2" parsed="|2Sam|8|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.8.14">2 Sam. viii, 14</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xviii. 13" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p10.3" parsed="|1Chr|18|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.18.13">1 Chron. xviii, 13</scripRef>, but more fully by Christ, <scripRef passage="Amos ix. 12" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p10.4" parsed="|Amos|9|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Amos.9.12">Amos ix, 12</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Obad. i. 18" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p10.5" parsed="|Obad|1|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Obad.1.18">Obad. i, 18</scripRef>, who shall subdue and possess all his enemies; here
signified by the name of Edom, as Jacob or Israel, his brother,
signifies all his church and people. Seir - A part and, mountain of
Edom.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p11">19. Out of Jacob - Out of Jacob's loins. He that shall
have dominion - David, and especially Christ. Of the city - Or from or
out of this city, that is, the cities, the singular number for the
plural. He shall not subdue those Moabites and Edomites which meet him
in the field, but he shall pursue them even to their strongest holds and
cities.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p12">20. He looked on Amalek - From the top of Pisgah, which
was exceeding high, and gave him the prospect of part of all these
kingdoms. The first - Hebrew. the firstfruits; so called either, because
they were the first of all the neighbouring nations which were embodied
together in one government: or, because he was the first who fought
against Israel and was vanquished by them. That victory was an earnest
and first-fruit of the large harvest of victories which the Israelites
should in due time get over all their enemies. He shall perish forever
- He began with God and with Israel, but God will end with him, and the
firm purpose of God is, that he shall be utterly destroyed; so that Saul
lost his kingdom for not executing this decree, and God's command
pursuant thereunto.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p13">21. The Kenites - The posterity or kindred of Jethro; not
that part of them which dwelt among the Israelites, to whom the
following words do not agree, but those of them who were mingled with
the Amalekites and Midianites. Thy nest - Thy dwelling-place, so called,
either because it was in an high place, as nests commonly are: or in
allusion to their name, for ken in Hebrew signifies a nest.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p14">22. The Kenite - Hebrew. Kain, that is, the Kenite, so
called, either by a transposition of letters, which is very usual in the
Hebrew tongue; or from the name of some eminent place where they lived,
or person from whom they were descended, though now the memory of them
be utterly lost, as it hath fared with innumerable other places and
persons, famous in their generations, mentioned in ancient Heathen
writers. Shall be wasted - Shall be by degrees diminished by the
incursions of divers enemies, till at last the Assyrian comes to
compleat the work and carries them into captivity. For the Kenites who
lived partly among the ten tribes, and partly with the two tribes, were
carried captive with them, part by Salmaneser, the King of Assyria, and
part by Nebuchadnezzar, who also is called an Assyrian, <scripRef passage="Ezra vi. 22" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Ezra|6|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.6.22">Ezra vi, 22</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Isaiah lii. 4" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p14.2" parsed="|Isa|52|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.52.4">Isaiah lii, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p15">23. Who shall live - How calamitous and miserable will
the state of the world be, when the Assyrian, and after him the
Chaldean, shall over-turn all these parts of the world? Who will be able
to keep his heart from fainting under such grievous pressures? Nay, how
few will escape the destroying sword?</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p16">24. Chittim - A place or people so called from Chittim
the son of Javan, <scripRef passage="Gen. x. 4" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Gen|10|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.10.4">Gen. x, 4</scripRef>, whose posterity were very numerous, and were first seated
in the lesser Asia, and from thence sent forth colonies into the islands
of the Aegean sea, and into Cyprus, afterwards into Macedonia and other
parts of Greece, and then into Italy. Whence it comes to pass that by
this name is understood sometimes Macedonia, as <scripRef passage="1 Maccabees. i. 1" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p16.2" parsed="|1Macc|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Macc.1.1">1 Maccabees. i. 1</scripRef>, and <scripRef passage="1 Maccabees. viii. 5" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p16.3" parsed="|1Macc|8|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Macc.8.5">1
Maccabees. viii. 5</scripRef>, sometimes Italy, as <scripRef passage="Dan. xi. 29, 30" id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p16.4" parsed="|Dan|11|29|11|30" osisRef="Bible:Dan.11.29-Dan.11.30">Dan. xi, 29, 30</scripRef>, and sometimes both, as in this place: for he speaks here of
the scourge that God hath appointed for the Assyrian after he had done
God's work in punishing of his people and the bordering nations. Now
although the Assyrian and Chaldean empire was subdued by the Medes and
Persians, yet the chief afflictions of that people came from two hands,
both beyond the sea and brought to them by ships; first from the
Grecians under Alexander and his successors, by whom that people were
grievously oppressed and wasted; then from the Romans, who subdued all
the Grecian empire, one great part whereof were the Assyrians largely so
called. Eber - The posterity of Eber, the Hebrew, who were the chief and
flower of Eber's children. He also - Not the Hebrew: they shall have a
better end; all Israel shall be saved; but the afflicter or scourge of
Ashur and Eber, namely, the Grecian and Roman empire. Thus Balaam,
instead of cursing the church, curses Amalek, the first, and Rome, the
last enemy of it!</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxv.ii-p17">25. To his place - To Mesopotamia; tho' afterwards he
returned to the Midianites, and gave them that devilish counsel which
was put in practice, chap. xxv, 16-18.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="48.37%" prev="ii.v.xxv.ii" next="ii.v.xxvi.i" id="ii.v.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXV" id="ii.v.xxvi-p0.1" parsed="|Num|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.25" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxvi-p0.2">XXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXV" progress="48.37%" prev="ii.v.xxvi" next="ii.v.xxvi.ii" id="ii.v.xxvi.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.i-p1">The sin of Israel, ver. 1-3. Their punishment, ver. 4, 5.
The zeal of Phinehas, with the promise annext to it, ver. 6-15. The
command to slay the Midianites, ver. 16-18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXV" progress="48.37%" prev="ii.v.xxvi.i" next="ii.v.xxvii" id="ii.v.xxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p1">1. Shittim - And this was their last station, from whence
they passed immediately into Canaan. This is noted as a great
aggravation of their sin, that they committed it, when God was going to
put them into the possession of their long-expected land. The people -
Many of them. Whoredom - Either because they prostituted themselves to
them upon condition of worshipping their God: or because their filthy
God was worshipped by such filthy acts, as Priapus and Venus were. The
daughters of Moab - And of Midian too; for both these people being
confederated in this wicked design, the one is put for the other, and
the daughters of Moab may be named, either because they began the
transgression, or because they were the chief persons, possibly, the
relations or courtiers of Balak.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p2">2. They - The Moabites being now neighbours to the
Israelites, and finding themselves unable to effect their design by war
and witchcraft, fell another way to work, by contracting familiarity
with them, and, perceiving their evil inclinations, they, that is, their
daughters, invited them. Unto the sacrifices - Unto the feasts which
were made of their parts of the sacrifices, after the manner of the Jews
and Gentiles too, the participation whereof, was reckoned a
participation in the worship of that God to whom the sacrifices were
offered. Of their gods - Of their God, Baal-peor, the plural Elohim
being here used, as commonly it is, for one God.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p3">3. Joined himself - The word implies a forsaking God to
whom they were joined and a turning to, and strict conjunction with,
this false God. Baal-peor - Called Baal, by the name common to many
false Gods, and especially to those that represented any of the heavenly
bodies, and Peor, either from the hill Peor, where he was worshipped,
chap. xxiii, 28, rather from a verb signifying to open and uncover,
because of the obscene posture in which the idol was set, as Priapus
was: or because of the filthiness which was exercised in his
worship.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p4">4. Take all the heads - Take, that is, apprehend, all the
heads, that is, the chief, of the people, such as were chief in this
transgression, and in place and power, who are singled out to this
exemplary punishment for their concurrence with others in this
wickedness, which was more odious and mischievous in them. Hang them up
before the Lord - To the vindication of God's honour and justice.
Against the sun - Publickly, as their sin was publick and scandalous,
and speedily, before the sun go down.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p5">5. Everyone his men - Those under his charge, for as
these seventy were chosen to assist Moses in the government, so
doubtless the care and management of the people was distributed among
them by just and equal proportions.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p6">6. One came - This was done, when Moses had given the
charge to the Judges, and, as it may seem, before the execution of it;
otherwise it is probable he would not have been so foolish to have run
upon certain ruin, when the examples were frequent before his eyes. To
his brethren -- into the camp of the Israelites. In the sight of Moses -
An argument of intolerable impudence and contempt of God and of Moses.
Weeping - Bewailing the wickedness of the people, and the dreadful
judgments of God, and imploring God's mercy and favour.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p7">8. Thrust them thro' - Phineas was himself a man in great
authority, and did this after the command given by Moses to the rulers
to slay these transgressors, and in the very sight, and no doubt by the
consent of Moses himself, and also by the special direction of God's
spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p8">9. Twenty four thousand - St. Paul says twenty three
thousand, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. x. 8" id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|1Cor|10|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10.8">1 Cor. x, 8</scripRef>. The odd thousand here added were slain by the Judges
according to the order of Moses, the rest by the immediate hand of God,
but both sorts died of the plague, the word being used, as often it is,
for the sword, or hand, or stroke of God.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p9">12. My covenant of peace - That is, the covenant of an
everlasting priesthood, as it is expounded, ver. 13, which is called a
covenant of peace, partly with respect to the happy effect of this
heroical action of his, whereby he made peace between God and his
people; and partly with regard to the principal end of the priestly
office, which was constantly to do that which Phinehas now did, even to
meditate between God and men, to obtain and preserve his own and
Israel's peace and reconciliation with God, by offering up sacrifices
and incense, and prayers, to God on their behalf, as also by turning
them away from iniquity, which is the only peace- breaker, and by
teaching and pressing the observation of that law, which is the only
bond of their peace.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p10">13. At everlasting priesthood - To continue as long as
the law and common-wealth of the Jews did. But this promise was
conditional, and therefore might be made void, by the miscarriages of
Phinehas's sons, as it seems it was, and thereupon a like promise was
made to Eli of the line of Ithamar, that he and his should walk before
the Lord, namely, in the office of high- priest, forever, which also
for his and their sins was made void, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. ii. 30" id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|1Sam|2|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.2.30">1 Sam. ii, 30</scripRef>. And the the priesthood returned to Phinehas's line in the
time of Solomon, <scripRef passage="1 Kings ii. 26, 27, 34" id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p10.2" parsed="|1Kgs|2|26|2|27;|1Kgs|2|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.2.26-1Kgs.2.27 Bible:1Kgs.2.34">1 Kings ii, 26, 27, 34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p11">17. The Midianites - And why not the Moabites. It is
probable the Midianites were most guilty, as in persuading Balak to send
for Balaam, chap. xxii, 4, 7. So in the reception of Balaam after Balak
had dismissed him, chap. xxxi, 8, and in farther consultation with him,
and in contriving the means for the executing of this wicked plot.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvi.ii-p12">18. With their wiles - For under pretense of kindred and
friendship and leagues, which they offered to them, instead of that war
which the Israelites expected, they sought only an opportunity to
insinuate themselves into their familiarity, and execute their hellish
plot of bringing that curse upon the Israelites, which they had in vain
attempted to bring another way.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="48.48%" prev="ii.v.xxvi.ii" next="ii.v.xxvii.i" id="ii.v.xxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXVI" id="ii.v.xxvii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.26" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxvii-p0.2">XXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVI" progress="48.48%" prev="ii.v.xxvii" next="ii.v.xxvii.ii" id="ii.v.xxvii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.i-p1">Orders for numbering the people, ver. 1-4. Their families
and number, ver. 5-51. Directions for dividing the land between them,
ver. 52-55. The families and number of the Levites, ver. 56- 62. Notice
taken of the death of them that were first numbered, ver. 62-65.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXVI" progress="48.48%" prev="ii.v.xxvii.i" next="ii.v.xxviii" id="ii.v.xxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p1">2. Take the sum - They were numbered twice before, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxx. 11, 12" id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|30|11|30|12" osisRef="Bible:Exod.30.11-Exod.30.12">Exod. xxx, 11, 12</scripRef> chap. i, 1, 2. Now they are numbered a third time, to
demonstrate the faithfulness of God, both in cutting all those off whom
he had threatened to cut off, chap. xiv, 29, and in a stupendous
increase of the people according to his promise, notwithstanding all
their sins, and the sweeping judgments inflicted upon them; and to
prepare the way for the equal division of the land, which they were now
going to possess.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p2">7. Families - The chief houses, which were subdivided
into divers lesser families. Forty three thousand seven hundred and
thirty - Whereas in their last numbering they were forty six thousand
five hundred; for Korah's conspiracy, as well as other provocations of
theirs, had cut off many of them.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p3">10. With Korah - According to this translation Korah was
not consumed by fire with his two hundred and fifty men, but swallowed
up by the earth. But others rather think he was devoured by the fire,
and render these words, and the things of Korah, or belonging to Korah,
namely, his tent and goods, and family, children excepted, as here
follows. A sign - God made them a monument or example, to warn others
not to rebel against God, or magistracy, nor to usurp the priestly
office.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p4">11. Died not - God being pleased to spare them, because
they disowned their father's fact, and separated themselves both from
his tent and company. Hence the sons of Korah are mentioned, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. vi. 22, 38" id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Chr|6|22|0|0;|1Chr|6|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.6.22 Bible:1Chr.6.38">1 Chron. vi, 22, 38</scripRef>, and often in the book of Psalms.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p5">12. Jachin - Called also Jarib, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. iv. 24" id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|1Chr|4|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.4.24">1 Chron. iv, 24</scripRef>. And such names might be either added or changed upon some
special occasion not recorded in scripture.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p6">14. Twenty two thousand and two hundred - No tribe
decreased so much as Simeon's. From fifty nine thousand and three
hundred it sunk to twenty two thousand and two hundred, little more than
a third part of what it was. One whole family of that tribe, (Ohad
mentioned <scripRef passage="Exod. vi. 15" id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Exod|6|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.6.15">Exod. vi, 15</scripRef>) was extinct in the wilderness. Some think most of the
twenty four thousand, cut off by the plague for the iniquity of Peor,
were of that tribe. For Zimri, a ring-leader in that iniquity, was a
prince of that tribe. Simeon is not mentioned in Moses's blessing, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxiii. 1-29" id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Deut|33|1|33|29" osisRef="Bible:Deut.33.1-Deut.33.29">Deut. xxxiii, 1-29</scripRef>. And the lot of that tribe in Canaan was inconsiderable,
only a canton out of Judah's lot, <scripRef passage="Josh. xix. 9" id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p6.3" parsed="|Josh|19|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.19.9">Josh. xix, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p7">18. Children of Gad - Fewer by above five thousand than
there were in their last numbering.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p8">22. The families of Judah - About two thousand more than
they were, chap. i, 27, whereas the foregoing tribes were all
diminished.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p9">34. Fifty two thousand and seven hundred - Whereas they
were but thirty two thousand and two hundred, in chap. i, 35. So they
are now increased above twenty thousand, according to that prophecy, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 22" id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Gen|49|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.22">Gen. xlix, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p10">38. The sons of Benjamin - Who were ten, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlvi. 21" id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Gen|46|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.46.21">Gen. xlvi, 21</scripRef>, whereof only five are here mentioned, the rest probably,
together with their families, being extinct.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p11">43. Threescore and four thousand and four hundred - All
from one son and family, whereas of Benjamin who had ten sons, and five
families, there were only forty five thousand and six hundred, to shew
that the increase of families depends singly upon God's blessing and
good pleasure.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p12">51. These were the numbered - Very nigh as many as there
were before, chap. i, 46. So wisely and marvelously did God at the same
time manifest his justice in cutting off so vast a number; his mercy in
giving such a speedy and numerous supply; and his truth in both.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p13">53. The land shall be divided - The land was divided into
nine parts and an half, respect being had in such division to the
goodness as well as to the largeness of the several portions, and the
lot gave each tribe their part. Of names - Of persons, the share of each
tribe was divided amongst the several families, to some more, to some
less, according to the number of the persons of each family. And withal,
if one of the portions proved too large or too little for the families
and persons of that tribe, they might give part of their portion to
another tribe, (as Simeon and Daniel had part of Judah's share) or take
away a part from the portion belonging to another tribe.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p14">55. By lot - For the tribes, not for the several
families; for the distribution of it to them was left to the rulers
wisdom according to the rule now given.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p15">56. Many and few - That share, which shall by lot fall to
each tribe, shall be distributed to the several families and persons in
such proportions as their numbers shall require.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxvii.ii-p16">65. Not left a man - Only of the Levites, who being not
guilty of that sin did not partake of their judgment.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="48.56%" prev="ii.v.xxvii.ii" next="ii.v.xxviii.i" id="ii.v.xxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXVII" id="ii.v.xxviii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.27" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxviii-p0.2">XXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVII" progress="48.56%" prev="ii.v.xxviii" next="ii.v.xxviii.ii" id="ii.v.xxviii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.i-p1">The case of Zelophehad's daughters determined, ver. 1-11.
Notice given to Moses of his death, ver. 12-14. His successor provided.
ver. 15-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXVII" progress="48.56%" prev="ii.v.xxviii.i" next="ii.v.xxix" id="ii.v.xxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p1">2. By the door of the tabernacle - Nigh unto which it
seems was the place where Moses and the chief rulers assembled for the
administration of publick affairs, which also was very convenient,
because they had frequent occasion of recourse to God for his
direction.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p2">3. In his own sin - For his own personal sins. It was a
truth, and that believed by the Jews that death was a punishment for
mens own sins.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p3">4. Be done away - As it will be, if it be not preserved
by an inheritance given to us in his name and for his sake. Hence some
gather, that the first son of each of these heiresses was called by
their father's name, by virtue of that law, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 6" id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Deut|25|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.6">Deut. xxv, 6</scripRef>, whereby the brother's first son was to bear the name of his
elder brother, whose widow he married. Give us a possession - In the
land of Canaan upon the division of it, which though not yet conquered,
they concluded would certainly be so, and thereby gave glory to God.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p4">10. No brethren -- nor sisters, as appears from ver.
8.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p5">11. A statute of judgment - A statute or rule, by which
the magistrates shall give judgment in such cases.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p6">12. Abarim - The whole tract of mountains was called
Abarim, whereof one of the highest was called Nebo, and the top of that
Pisgah.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p7">13. Thou shalt be gathered unto thy people - Moses must
die: but death does not cut him off; it only gathers him to his people,
brings him to rest with the holy patriarchs that were gone before him.
Abraham, Isaac and Jacob were his people, the people of his choice, and
to them death gathered him.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p8">15. And Moses spake unto the Lord - Concerning his
successor. We should concern ourselves both in our prayers and in our
endeavours for the rising generation, that God's kingdom may be advanced
among men, when we are in our graves.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p9">16. The Lord of the spirits of all flesh - God of all
men: the searcher of spirits, that knowest who is fit for this great
employment; the father and giver and governor of spirits, who canst
raise and suit the spirits of men to the highest and hardest works.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p10">17. Go out before them - That is, who may wisely conduct
them in all their affairs, both when they go forth to war, or upon other
occasions, and when they return home and live in peace. A metaphor from
shepherds, who in those places used not to go behind their sheep, as
ours now do, but before them, and to lead them forth to their pasture,
and in due time to lead them home again.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p11">18. The spirit - The spirit of government, of wisdom, and
of the fear of the Lord. Lay thy hand - By which ceremony Moses did both
design the person and confer the power, and by his prayers, which
accompanied that rite, obtain from God all the spiritual gifts and
graces necessary for his future employment.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p12">19. Before all the congregation - That they may be
witnesses of the whole action, and may acknowledge him for their supreme
ruler. Give him charge - Thou shalt give him counsels and instructions
for the right management of that great trust.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p13">20. Put some of thine honour - Thou shalt not now use him
as a servant, but as a brother and thy partner in the government, that
the people being used to obey him while Moses lived, might do it
afterward the more cheerfully.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p14">21. Who shall ask counsel for him - When he requires him
to do so, and in important and difficult matters. Of Urim - Urim is put
for both Urim and Thummim. Before the Lord - Ordinarily in the
tabernacle near the second veil setting his face to the ark. At his word
- The word of the Lord, delivered to him by the high priest.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxviii.ii-p15">22. And Moses did as the Lord commanded him - It had been
little to resign his honour to a son of his own. But with his own hands,
first to ordain Eleazar high-priest, and now Joshua chief ruler, while
his own children had no preferment at all, but were left in the rank of
common Levites: this was more to his glory than the highest advancement
of his family could have been. This shews him to have had a principle
which raised him above all other lawgivers, who always took care to
establish their families in some share of the greatness themselves
possessed.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVIII" progress="48.64%" prev="ii.v.xxviii.ii" next="ii.v.xxix.i" id="ii.v.xxix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXVIII" id="ii.v.xxix-p0.1" parsed="|Num|28|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.28" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxix-p0.2">XXVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVIII" progress="48.64%" prev="ii.v.xxix" next="ii.v.xxix.ii" id="ii.v.xxix.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxix.i-p1">Laws concerning the daily, ver. 1-8. Weekly, ver. 9-10.
Monthly, ver. 11-15. Yearly sacrifices, ver. 16-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXVIII" progress="48.64%" prev="ii.v.xxix.i" next="ii.v.xxx" id="ii.v.xxix.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxix.ii-p1">2. Command the children of Israel - God here repeats some
of the former laws about sacrifices, not without great reason, partly
because they had been generally discontinued for thirty eight years
together; partly because the generation to which the former laws had
been given about these things was wholly dead, and it was fit the new
generation should be instructed about them, as their parents were;
partly to renew their testimonies of God's grace and mercy,
notwithstanding their frequent forfeitures thereof by their rebellion:
and principally because they were now ready to enter into that land, in
which they were obliged to put these things in practice.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxix.ii-p2">7. In the holy place - Upon the altar of burnt offerings,
which was in the court of the priests, nigh to the entrance into the
sanctuary.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxix.ii-p3">17. The feast - Namely, of unleavened bread.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxix.ii-p4">23. In the morning - And that in the evening too, as is
evident from other scriptures; but the morning-sacrifice alone is
mentioned, because the celebration of the feast began with it, and
principally because this alone was doubtful, whether this might not be
omitted when so many other sacrifices were offered in that morning,
whereas there was no question but the evening sacrifice should be
offered, when there were none other to be offered.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxix.ii-p5">26. The day of the first fruits - In the feast of
pentecost, <scripRef passage="Acts ii. 1" id="ii.v.xxix.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Acts|2|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.2.1">Acts ii, 1</scripRef>. Your weeks - The seven weeks which you are to number from
the passover.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIX" progress="48.66%" prev="ii.v.xxix.ii" next="ii.v.xxx.i" id="ii.v.xxx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXIX" id="ii.v.xxx-p0.1" parsed="|Num|29|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.29" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxx-p0.2">XXIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIX" progress="48.66%" prev="ii.v.xxx" next="ii.v.xxx.ii" id="ii.v.xxx.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxx.i-p1">Offerings to be made in the seventh month,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.xxx.i-p2">1. At the feast of trumpets, ver. 1-6.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.xxx.i-p3">2. In the day of atonement, ver. 7-11.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.v.xxx.i-p4">3. At the feast of tabernacles, ver.
12-40.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXIX" progress="48.67%" prev="ii.v.xxx.i" next="ii.v.xxxi" id="ii.v.xxx.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxx.ii-p1">6. Of the month - Belonging to every new moon.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxx.ii-p2">7. Afflict your souls - Yourselves, by fasting and
abstinence from all delightful things, and by compunction for your sins,
and the judgments of God, either deserved by you or inflicted upon
you.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxx.ii-p3">12. Seven days - Not by abstaining so long from all
servile work, but by offering extraordinary sacrifices each day. This
was the Feast of Tabernacles. And all the days of their dwelling in
booths, they must offer sacrifices. While we are in these tabernacles,
'tis our interest as well as duty, to keep up our communion with God.
Nor will the unsettledness of our outward condition, excuse our neglect
of God's worship.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXX" progress="48.68%" prev="ii.v.xxx.ii" next="ii.v.xxxi.i" id="ii.v.xxxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXX" id="ii.v.xxxi-p0.1" parsed="|Num|30|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.30" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxxi-p0.2">XXX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXX" progress="48.68%" prev="ii.v.xxxi" next="ii.v.xxxi.ii" id="ii.v.xxxi.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxxi.i-p1">A general rule, vows must be performed, ver. 1-3.
Particular exceptions, of the vow of a daughter, not allowed by the
father, ver. 3-5. And the vow of a wife, not allowed by her husband, 6-
16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXX" progress="48.68%" prev="ii.v.xxxi.i" next="ii.v.xxxii" id="ii.v.xxxi.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxxi.ii-p1">5. In the days - Speedily, or without delay, allowing
only convenient time for deliberation. And it is hereby intimated, that
the day or time he had for disallowing her vow, was not to be reckoned
from her vowing, but from his knowledge of her vow. The Lord shall
forgive - Or, will forgive her not performing it. But this should be
understood only of vows which could not be performed without invading
the father's right; for if one should vow to forbear such, or such a
sin, and all occasions or means leading to it, and to perform such, or
such duties, when he had opportunity, no father can discharge him from
such vows. If this law does not extend to children's marrying without
the parent's consent, so far as to put it in the power of the parent, to
disannul the marriage, (which some think it does) yet certainly it
proves the sinfulness of such marriages, and obliges those children to
repent and humble themselves before God and their parents.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxi.ii-p2">9. Widow or divorced - Though she be in her father's
house, whither such persons often returned.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxi.ii-p3">10. If she vowed - If she that now a widow, or divorced,
made that vow while her husband lived with her; as suppose she then
vowed, that if she was a widow, she would give such a proportion of her
estate to pious or charitable uses, of which vow she might repent when
she came to be a widow, and might believe or repented she was free from
it, because that vow was made in her husband's lifetime; this is
granted, in case her husband then disallowed it; but denied, in case by
silence, or otherwise he consented to it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxi.ii-p4">13. To afflict her soul - Herself by fasting, by
watching, or the like. And these words are added to shew that the
husband had this power not only in those vows which concerned himself or
his estate, but also in those which might seem only to concern her own
person, or body, and the reason is, because the wife's person or body
being the husband's right; she might not do any thing to the injury of
her body without his consent.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxi.ii-p5">15. After he hath heard - And approved them by his
silence from day to day, if after that time he shall hinder it, which he
ought not to do: her non-performance of her vow shall be imputed to him,
not to her.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXI" progress="48.72%" prev="ii.v.xxxi.ii" next="ii.v.xxxii.i" id="ii.v.xxxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXXI" id="ii.v.xxxii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|31|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.31" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxxii-p0.2">XXXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXI" progress="48.72%" prev="ii.v.xxxii" next="ii.v.xxxii.ii" id="ii.v.xxxii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.i-p1">God commands Moses to avenge Israel of the Midianites,
ver. 1, 2. Moses sends them to the war, ver. 3-6. They slay the
Midianites, ver. 7-12. He reproves them for sparing the women, ver.
13-18. Directions for purifying themselves, ver. 19-24. The distribution
of the spirit, ver. 25-47. The free-will-offering of the officers, ver.
48-54.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXXI" progress="48.73%" prev="ii.v.xxxii.i" next="ii.v.xxxiii" id="ii.v.xxxii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p1">3. Avenge ye the Lord - For the affront which they
offered to God, by their own idolatry and lewdness, and by seducing
God's people into rebellion against him. God's great care was to avenge
the Israelites, ver. 2, and Moses's chief desire was to avenge God
rather than himself or the people.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p2">5. Twelve thousand - God would send no more, though it is
apparent the Midianites were numerous and strong, because he would
exercise their trust in him, and give them an earnest of their
Canaanitish conquests.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p3">6. Them and Phinehas - Who had the charge not of the
army, as general, (an office never committed to a priest in all the Old
Testament) but of the holy instruments, and was sent to encourage, and
quicken, them in their enterprize. The holy instruments - The holy
breast-plate, wherein was the Urim and Thummim, which was easily
carried, and very useful in war upon many emergent occasions.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p4">7. All the males - Namely all who lived in those parts,
for colonies of them, were sent forth to remoter places, which therefore
had no hand either in their former sin, or in this present ruling. And
herein they did according to God's own order concerning such people, <scripRef passage="Deut. xx. 13" id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Deut|20|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.20.13">Deut. xx, 13</scripRef>, only their fault was, that they did not consider the
special reason which they had to involve the women in the
destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p5">13. Without the camp - Partly to put respect upon them,
and congratulate with them for their happy success; and partly to
prevent the pollution of the camp by the untimely entrance of the
warriors into it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p6">17. The little ones - Which they were forbidden to do to
other people, <scripRef passage="Deut. xx. 14" id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Deut|20|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.20.14">Deut. xx, 14</scripRef>, except the Canaanites, to whom this people had equaled
themselves by their horrid crimes, and therefore it is not strange, nor
unjust, that God, the supreme Lord of all mens lives, who as he gives
them, so may take them away when he pleaseth, did equal them in the
punishment. Every woman -Partly for punishment, because the guilt was
general, and though some of them only did prostitute themselves to the
Israelites, yet the rest made themselves accessary by their consent or
approbation; and partly, for prevention of the like mischief from such
an adulterous generation.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p7">20. Your raiment - Namely, your spoil and prey. All work
- All which had contracted some ceremonial uncleanness either from the
dead bodies which wore them, or the tents or houses where they were, in
which such dead bodies lay, or from the touch of the Israelitish
soldiers, who were legally defiled by the slaughters they made.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p8">27. Two parts - The congregation hath some share, because
the warriors went in the name of all, and because all having been
injured by the Midianites, all were to have some share in the
reparations: but the warriors who were but 12000, have a far greater
share than their brethren, because they underwent greater pains and
dangers.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p9">29. An heave-offering - In thankfulness to God for their
preservation and good success.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p10">30. One of fifty - Whereas the former part was one of
five hundred; the reason of the difference is, partly, because this was
taken out of the peoples portion, whose hazards being less than the
others, their gains also in all reason were to be less: partly because
this was to be distributed into more hands, the Levites being now
numerous, whereas the priests were but few.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxii.ii-p11">50. An atonement - For their error noted, ver. 14, 15,
16, and withal for a memorial, or by way of gratitude for such a
stupendous assistance and deliverance. We should never take any thing to
ourselves in war or trade, of which we cannot in faith consecrate a part
to God, who hates robbery for burnt-offerings. But when God has
remarkably preserved and succeeded us, he expects we should make some
particular return of gratitude to him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXII" progress="48.79%" prev="ii.v.xxxii.ii" next="ii.v.xxxiii.i" id="ii.v.xxxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXXII" id="ii.v.xxxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|32|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.32" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxxiii-p0.2">XXXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXII" progress="48.79%" prev="ii.v.xxxiii" next="ii.v.xxxiii.ii" id="ii.v.xxxiii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.i-p1">The request of Reuben and Gad for an inheritance on this
side Jordan, ver. 1-5. Moses's misconstruction of it, ver. 6-15. Their
explication of it, ver. 16-19. The grant of their petition, ver.
20-42.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXXII" progress="48.80%" prev="ii.v.xxxiii.i" next="ii.v.xxxiv" id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p1">1. Jazer - A city and country of the Amorites; Gilead - A
mountainous country, famous for pasturage</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p2">6. Ye sit here - In ease and peace, while your brethren
are engaged in a bloody war.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p3">12. The Kenezite - So called from Kenaz, his
grand-father.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p4">15. All this people - Who being moved by your counsel and
example, will refuse to go over Jordan.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p5">17. We ourselves - Either all, or as many as shall be
thought necessary, leaving only so many as may be necessary to provide
for the sustenance and defense of our wives and children here.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p6">20. Before the Lord - Before the ark, which was the token
of God's presence. He alludes either to the order of the tribes in their
march, whereby Reuben and Gad marched immediately before the ark, or to
the manner of their passage over Jordan, wherein the ark went first into
Jordan, and stood there while all the tribes marched over Jordan by and
before it, and these amongst the rest, as is expressly noted in these
very words, that they passed over before the Lord, <scripRef passage="Josh. iv. 13" id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Josh|4|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.4.13">Josh. iv, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p7">22. Before the Lord - By his presence and gracious and
powerful assistance.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p8">23. Your sin - The punishment of your sin. Sin will
certainly find out the sinner sooner or later. It concerns us therefore
to find our sins out, that we may repent of them and forsake them, lest
our sins find us out, to our confusion and destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p9">30. They shall have possession - They shall forfeit their
possessions in Gilead, and be constrained to go over Jordan, and to seek
possessions there among their brethren.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p10">31. As the Lord hath said - Either at this time by thy
mouth: or formerly, where he commanded us, as well as our brethren to go
into Canaan and possess it.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p11">34. Built - Repaired and fortified. For they neither had
need nor leisure as yet to do more, the old cities not being burnt and
ruined, as divers in Canaan were.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p12">38. Their names changed - Either because conquerers of
places used to do so: or because the names of other Gods (which Nebo and
Baal-meon unquestionably were) were not to be mentioned, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiii. 13" id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Exod|23|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.23.13">Exod. xxiii, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p13">40. Machir - Not to Machir himself, who doubtless was
long since dead, but the family or posterity of Machir.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiii.ii-p14">42. Nobah - Who, though not else where named, was
doubtless an eminent person of the tribe of Manasseh. 'Tis observable,
that these tribes, as they were placed before the other tribes, so they
were displaced before them. They were carried captive by the king of
Assyria, some years before the other tribes. Such a proportion does
providence frequently observe, in balancing prosperity and
adversity.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIII" progress="48.84%" prev="ii.v.xxxiii.ii" next="ii.v.xxxiv.i" id="ii.v.xxxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXXIII" id="ii.v.xxxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Num|33|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.33" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxxiv-p0.2">XXXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXIII" progress="48.84%" prev="ii.v.xxxiv" next="ii.v.xxxiv.ii" id="ii.v.xxxiv.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxxiv.i-p1">An account of the marches and encampments of the
Israelites, from Egypt to Canaan, ver. 1-49. A strict command to drive
out all the Canaanites.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXXIII" progress="48.84%" prev="ii.v.xxxiv.i" next="ii.v.xxxv" id="ii.v.xxxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxxiv.ii-p1">2. And Moses wrote their goings out - When they set out,
God ordered him to keep a journal of all the remarkable occurrences in
the way, that it might be a satisfaction to himself and an instruction
to others. It may be of use to Christians, to preserve an account of the
providences of God concerning them, the constant series of mercies they
have experienced, and especially those turns which have made some days
of their lives more remarkable.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiv.ii-p2">4. On their gods - Their false gods, namely those beasts
which the brutish Egyptians worshipped as gods, which were killed with
the rest, for the first-born both of men and beasts were then killed.
Probably their images likewise were thrown down, as Dagon afterward
before the ark.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiv.ii-p3">10. By the Red-sea - By another part of that sea which
they passed over.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiv.ii-p4">48. Shittim - The place where the people sinned in the
matter of Peor, is here called Abel-Shittim - Abel signifies mourning;
and probably this place was so called, from the mourning of Israel for
that sin, and the heavy punishment inflicted on the sinners.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxiv.ii-p5">52. Drive out - Not by banishing, but by destroying them.
Pictures - Which seem to have been stones curiously engraven, and set up
for worship. High Places - Chapels, altars, groves, or other means of
worship there set up.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIV" progress="48.87%" prev="ii.v.xxxiv.ii" next="ii.v.xxxv.i" id="ii.v.xxxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXXIV" id="ii.v.xxxv-p0.1" parsed="|Num|34|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.34" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxxv-p0.2">XXXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXIV" progress="48.87%" prev="ii.v.xxxv" next="ii.v.xxxv.ii" id="ii.v.xxxv.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxxv.i-p1">Directions concerning the bounds of Canaan, ver. 1-15.
Concerning the division of it, ver. 16-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXXIV" progress="48.87%" prev="ii.v.xxxv.i" next="ii.v.xxxvi" id="ii.v.xxxv.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p1">2. Coasts - Or limits or bounds, to wit, of the land
beyond Jordan. Which are here particularly described,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p2">1. to direct and bound them in their wars
and conquests, that they might not seek the enlargement of their empire,
after the manner of other nations, but be contented with their own
portion.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p3">2. To encourage them in their attempt upon
Canaan, and assure them of their success. There was a much larger
possession promised them, if they were obedient, even to the river
Euphrates. But this, which is properly Canaan, lay in a very little
compass. 'Tis but about an hundred and fifty miles in length, and about
fifty in breadth. This was that little spot of ground, in which alone
for many ages God was known! But its littleness was abundantly
compensated by its fruitfulness: otherwise it could not have sustained
so numerous a nation. See, how little a share of the world God often
gives to his own people! But they that have their portion in heaven, can
be content with a small pittance of this earth.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p4">3. Your fourth quarter - Which is here described from
east to west by divers windings and turnings, by reason of the mountains
and rivers. The salt sea - So called from the salt and sulphurous taste
of its waters. Eastward - That is, at the eastern part of that sea,
where the eastern and southern borders meet.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p5">4. From the south - Or, on the south, that is, proceeding
onward towards the south. Azmon - Which is at the west-end of the mount
of Edom.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p6">5. The river of Egypt - Called Sihor, <scripRef passage="Josh. xiii. 3" id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Josh|13|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.13.3">Josh. xiii, 3</scripRef>, which divided Egypt from Canaan. The sea - The midland sea,
called the sea emphatically, whereas the other seas, as they are called,
are indeed but lakes.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p7">6. The great sea - This midland sea from the south to the
north, so far as it runs parallel with mount Libanus.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p8">7. Hor - Not that Hor where Aaron died, which was
southward, and bordering upon Edom, but another mountain, and, as it is
conceived, the mountain of Libanus, which is elsewhere mentioned as the
northern border of the land, and which, in regard of divers parts, or by
divers people, is called by divers names, and here Hor, which signifies
a mountain, by way of eminency.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p9">17. Eleazar - Who was to act in God's name, to cast lots,
to prevent contentions, to consult with God in cases of difficulty, to
transact the whole business in a solemn and religious manner.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxv.ii-p10">19. Judah - The order of the tribes is here different
from that, chap. i, 7, 26, and in other places, being conformed to the
order of their several inheritances, which afterwards fell to them by
lots. Which is an evident demonstration of the infinite wisdom of God's
providence, and of his peculiar care over his people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXV" progress="48.92%" prev="ii.v.xxxv.ii" next="ii.v.xxxvi.i" id="ii.v.xxxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXXV" id="ii.v.xxxvi-p0.1" parsed="|Num|35|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.35" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxxvi-p0.2">XXXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXV" progress="48.92%" prev="ii.v.xxxvi" next="ii.v.xxxvi.ii" id="ii.v.xxxvi.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.i-p1">Forty eight cities assigned to the Levites, of which six
were cities of refuge, ver. 1-15. In what cases it was not allowed to
flee to these, ver. 16-21. In what cases it was allowed, ver. 22- 24.
Laws concerning them, ver. 25-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXXV" progress="48.92%" prev="ii.v.xxxvi.i" next="ii.v.xxxvii" id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p1">3. For the cattle - For pasturage for their cattle: where
they might not build houses, nor plant gardens, orchards or vineyards,
no nor sow corn, for which they were abundantly provided out of the
first-fruits. And these suburbs did not belong to the Levites in common,
but were distributed to them in convenient proportions.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p2">4. A thousand cubits - In the next verse it is two
thousand. But this verse and the next do not speak to the same thing;
this speaks of the space from whence the suburbs shall be measured, the
next speaks of the space unto which that measure shall be extended; and
the words may very well be read thus. And the suburbs - Shall be from
the wall of the city and from without it, or, from the outward parts of
it, even from a thousand cubits round about. Which are mentioned not as
the thing measured, but as the space from which the measuring line
should begin. And then it follows, ver. 5. And ye shall measure from
without the city, (not from the wall of the city, as said before ver. 4,
but from without it, that is, from the said outward space of a thousand
cubits without the wall of the city round about) on the east side two
thousand cubits. So in truth there were three thousand cubits from the
wall of the city, whereof one thousand probably were for out-houses,
stalls for cattle, gardens, vineyards and olive-yards, and the other two
thousand for pasture, which are therefore called the field of the
suburbs, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxv. 34" id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Lev|25|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.25.34">Lev. xxv, 34</scripRef>, by way of distinction from the suburbs themselves, which
consist of the first thousand cubits from the wall of the city.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p3">6. Cities for refuge - Or, of escape for manslayers: And
these cities are assigned among the Levites, partly because they might
be presumed to be the most proper and impartial Judges between
man-slayers, and wilful murderers; partly because their presence and
authority would more effectually bridle the passions of the avenger of
blood who might pursue him thither; and perhaps to signify, that it is
only in Christ (whom the Levitical priests represented) that sinners
find refuge and safety from the destroyer.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p4">11. Unawares - Not wilfully, designedly or maliciously,
but through mistake or indiscretion.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p5">12. From the avenger - Hebrew. from the redeemer, or,
from the next kinsman, to whom by the law belonged the right of
redemption of the lands of; and vindication of the injury done to, the
person deceased. Die not - Be not killed by the avenger meeting him in
some other place. Before the congregation - Before the Judges or elders
who were appointed in every city for the decision of criminal causes,
who were to examine, and that publickly before the people, whether the
murder was wilful or casual.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p6">14. On this side Jordan - Because that land was as long
as Canaan, though not so broad, and besides these might be convenient
for many of them that lived in Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p7">16. If he smite him - Wittingly and wilfully, though not
with premeditated malice. He shall be put to death - Yea though he were
fled into the city of refuge.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p8">19. He shall slay him - Either by himself, as the
following words shew; so it is a permission, that he may do it without
offense to God or danger to himself: or by the magistrate, from whom he
shall demand justice: so it is a command.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p9">24. Then - If the man-slayer flee to to the city of
refuge.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p10">26. He shall abide in it - Be confined to it, partly to
shew the hatefulness of murder in God's account by so severe a
punishment, inflicted upon the very appearance of it, and partly for the
security of the man-slayer, lest the presence of such a person, and his
conversation among the kindred of the deceased, might occasion reproach
and blood-shed. The death of the high- priest - Perhaps to shew that the
death of Christ (the true High- priest, whom the others represented) is
the only means whereby sins are pardoned and sinners set at liberty.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvi.ii-p11">27. Not guilty - Not liable to punishment from men,
though not free of guilt before God. This God ordained to oblige the
man- slayer to abide in his city of refuge.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXVI" progress="48.99%" prev="ii.v.xxxvi.ii" next="ii.v.xxxvii.i" id="ii.v.xxxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Num. XXXVI" id="ii.v.xxxvii-p0.1" parsed="|Num|36|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.36" /> 
<h3 id="ii.v.xxxvii-p0.2">XXXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXVI" progress="48.99%" prev="ii.v.xxxvii" next="ii.v.xxxvii.ii" id="ii.v.xxxvii.i">

<p id="ii.v.xxxvii.i-p1">An inconvenience if heiresses should marry into another
tribe, ver. 1-4. An appointment that they should marry in their own
tribe, ver. 5-9. Zelophehad's daughters marry their cousins, ver. 10-12.
The conclusion, ver.13.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary On Chapter XXXVI" progress="49.00%" prev="ii.v.xxxvii.i" next="ii.vi" id="ii.v.xxxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.v.xxxvii.ii-p1">2. Our brother - Our kinsman.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvii.ii-p2">6. To the family - They seem hereby to be confined not
only to the same tribe, but also to the family of their tribe, as
appears from the reason of the law, for God would have the inheritance
of families as well as tribes kept entire and unmixed.</p>

<p id="ii.v.xxxvii.ii-p3">8. The inheritance of his fathers - This law was not
general to forbid every woman to marry into another tribe, as may be
reasonably concluded from the practice of so many patriarchs, kings,
priests, and other holy men, who have married women of other tribes, yea
sometimes of other nations, but restrained to heiresses, or such as were
likely to be so. But if they had brethren, they were free to marry into
any tribe, yet so that, if their brethren died, the inheritance went
from them to the next a-kin of their father's tribe and family. And the
principal reason why God was solicitous to preserve tribes and families
unmixed was, that the tribe and family too, out of which the Messiah was
to come, and by which he should be known, might be evident and
unquestionable.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE FIFTH BOOK OF MOSES CALLED DEUTERONOMY" progress="49.01%" prev="ii.v.xxxvii.ii" next="ii.vi.i" id="ii.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut" id="ii.vi-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.vi-p0.2">NOTES ON THE FIFTH BOOK OF MOSES CALLED DEUTERONOMY</h2> 

<p id="ii.vi-p1">THE Greek interpreters call this book Deuteronomy, that is,
The second law, or a second edition of the law, bccause it is a
repetition of many of the laws, (as well as much of the history
contained in the three foregoing books. They to whom the first law was
given were all dead, and a new generation sprung up, to whom God would
have it repeated by Moses himself, that it might make the deeper
impression upon them. It begins with a brief rehearsal of the most
remarkable events, that had befallen them since they came from mount
Sinai. In the fourth chapter begins a pathetic exhortation to obedience:
From the 12th to the 27th are repeated many particular laws, inforced in
the 27th and 28th with promises and threatnings, which are formed into a
covenant, chap. 29, 30. Care is taken in chap. 31. to perpetuate the
remembrance of these things among them, particularly by a song, chap. 32
concluded with a blessing, chap. 33. All this was delivered by Moses to
Israel, in the last month of his life. See how busy this great and good
Man was to do good, when he knew his time was short.</p>

<div3 title="I" progress="49.04%" prev="ii.vi" next="ii.vi.i.i" id="ii.vi.i">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. I" id="ii.vi.i-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.i-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="49.04%" prev="ii.vi.i" next="ii.vi.i.ii" id="ii.vi.i.i">

<p id="ii.vi.i.i-p1">The preface, fixing the time and place, ver. 1-5. Israel
commanded to march, ver. 6-8. Judges provided, ver. 9-1; 3. They come to
Kadesh-barnea, ver. 19-21. Spies sent, their report, the people's
murmuring, ver. 22-33. The sentence passed upon them, ver. 34-40. They
are smitten by the Amorites, and remain at Kadesh, ver. 41-46.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="49.04%" prev="ii.vi.i.i" next="ii.vi.ii" id="ii.vi.i.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p1">1. All Israel - Namely, by the heads or elders of the
several tribes, who were to communicate these discourses to all the
people. In the wilderness - In the plain of Moab, as may appear by
comparing this with ver. 5, and <scripRef passage="Num. xxii. 1" id="ii.vi.i.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Num|22|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.22.1">Num. xxii, 1</scripRef>, and chap. xxxiv, 8. The word Suph here used does not
signify the Red-Sea, which is commonly called jam-suph, and which was at
too great a distance, but some oiher place now unknown to us, (as also
most of the following places are) so called from the reeds or flags, or
rushes (which that word signifies) that grew in or near it. Paran - Not
that <scripRef passage="Num. x. 12" id="ii.vi.i.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Num|10|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.10.12">Num. x, 12</scripRef>, which there and elsewhere is called the Wilderness of
Paran, and which was too remote, but some other place called by the same
name. Laban, Hazeroth, and Dizahab - These places seem to be the several
bounds, not of the whole country of Moab, but of the plain of Moab,
where Moses now was.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p2">2. There are eleven days journey - This is added to shew
that the reason why the Israelites, in so many years were advanced no
farther from Horeb, than to these plains, was not the distance of the
places but because of their rebellions. Kadesh-barnea - Which was not
far from the borders of Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p3">3. The eleventh month - Which was but a little before his
death. All that the Lord had given him in commandment - Which shews not
only that what he now delivered was in substance the same with what had
formerly been commanded, but that God now commanded him to repeat it. He
gave this rehearsal and exhortation by divine direction: God appointed
him to leave this legacy to the church.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p4">4. Og - His palace or mansion-house was at Astaroth, and
he was slain at Edrei.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p5">7. To the mount of the Amorites - That is, to the
mountainous country where the Amorites dwelt, which is opposed to the
plain, where others of them dwelt. And this is the first mentioned,
because it was in the borders of the land.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p6">8. Before you - Hebrew. Before your faces; it is open to
your view, and to your possession; there is no impediment in the
way.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p7">9. At that time - That is, about that time, namely, a
little before their coming to Horeb.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p8">12. Your burden - The trouble of ruling and managing so
perverse a people. Your strife - Your contentions among yourselves, for
the determnination whereof the elders were appointed.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p9">15. Officers - Inferior officers, that were to attend
upon the superior magistrates, and to execute their decrees.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p10">16. The stranger - That converseth or dealeth with himn.
To Such God would have justice equally adtninistred as to his own
people, partly for the honour of religion, and partly for the interest
which every man hath in matters of common right.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p11">17. Respect persons - Hebrew. Not know, or acknowledge
faces, that is, not give sentence according to the outward qualities of
the person, as he is poor or rich, your friend or enemy, but purely
according to the merit of the cause. For which reason some of the
Grecian law-givers ordered that the Judges should give sentence in the
dark where they could not see mens faces. The judgment is God's - It is
passed in the name of God, and by commission from him, by you as
representing his person, and doing his work; who therefore will defend
you therein against all your enemies, amid to whom you must give an
exact account.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p12">18. All the things which ye shall do - I delivered unto
you, and especially unto your Judges, all the laws, statutes, and
judgments revealed unto me by the Lord in Horeb.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p13">24. Eshcol - That is, of grapes, so called from the
goodly cluster of grapes which they brought from thence.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p14">28. Greater - In number and strength and valour.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p15">31. Bare thee - Or, carried thee, as a father carries his
weak and tender child in his arms, through difficulties and dangers,
gently leading you according as you are able to go, and sustaining you
by his power and goodness.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p16">32. Ye did not believe the Lord - So they could not enter
in, because of unbelief. It was not any other sin shut them out of
Canaan, but their disbelief of that promise, which was typical of gospel
grace: to signify that no sin will ruin us but unbelief, which is a sin
against the remedy; and therefore without remedy.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p17">33. Your words - That is to say, your murmurings, your
unthankful, impatient, distrustful and rebellious speeches.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p18">36. Save Caleb - Under whom Josh. is comprehended, though
not here expressed, because he was not now to be one of the people, but
to be set over them as a chief governor.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p19">37. For your sakes - Upon occasion of your wickedness and
perverseness, by which you provoked me to speak unadvisedly.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p20">38. Who standeth - Who is now thy servant.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.i.ii-p21">44. As bees - As bees which being provoked come out of
their hives in great numbers, and with great fury pursue their adversary
and disturber.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="49.12%" prev="ii.vi.i.ii" next="ii.vi.ii.i" id="ii.vi.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. II" id="ii.vi.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.ii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="49.12%" prev="ii.vi.ii" next="ii.vi.ii.ii" id="ii.vi.ii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.ii.i-p1">Their march from Kadesh-barnea, ver. 1-3. A charge not to
trouble the Edomites, ver. 4-8. Nor the Moabites, ver. 9-12. (They pass
the river Zered, ver. 13-16.) Nor the Ammonites, ver. 17-23. A command
to attack Sihon, ver. 24-26. The conquest of his kingdom, ver. 27-37</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="49.13%" prev="ii.vi.ii.i" next="ii.vi.iii" id="ii.vi.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p1">1. Mount Seir - The mountainous country of Seir or Edom.
Many days - Even for thirty eight years.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p2">3. Northward - Towards the land of the Amorites and
Canaanites.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p3">6. Buy meat - For thongh the manna did yet rain upon
them, they were not forbidden to buy other meats when they had
opportunity, but only were forbidden greedily to hunger after them when
they could not obtain them. Buy water - For water in those parts was
scarce, and therefore private persons did severally dig pits for their
particular use.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p4">7. The Lord hath blessed thee - By God's blessing thou
art able to buy thy conveniences, and therefore thy theft and rapine
will be inexcusable, because without any pretense of necessity. He
knoweth - Hebrew. He hath known, that is, observed, or regarded with
care and kindness, which that word often notes. Which experience of
God's singular goodness to thee, should make thee rely on him still, and
not use any unjust practice to procure what thou wantest or
desirest.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p5">8. We turned - From our direct road which lay through
Edom.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p6">9. Ar - The chief city of the Moabites, here put for the
whole country which depended upon it. The children of Lot - So called to
signify that this preservation, was not for their sakes, for they were a
wicked people, but for Lot's sake whose memory God yet honours.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p7">10. The Emims - Men terrible for stature and strength, as
their very name imparts, whose expulsion by the Moabites is here noted
as a great encouragement to the Israelites, for whose sake he would much
more drive out the wicked and accursed Canaanites.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p8">12. Which the Lord gave - The past tense is here put for
the future, will give after the manner of the prophets.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p9">23. The Caphtorim - A people a-kin to the Philistines, <scripRef passage="Gen. x. 14" id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Gen|10|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.10.14">Gen. x, 14</scripRef>, and confederate with them in this enterprize, and so
dwelling together, and by degrees uniting together by marriages, they
became one people. Caphtor - Which is by the learned thought to be
Cappadocia: whither these people might make an expedition out of Egypt,
either because of the report of the great riches of part of that country
which drew others thither from places equally remote, or for some other
reason now unknown.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p10">25. Under heaven - The following words rest rain the
sentence to those nations that heard of them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p11">28. On my feet - Or, with my company who are on foot:
which is added significantly, because if their army had consisted as
much of horsemen as many other armies did, their passage through his
land might have been more mischievous and dangerous.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p12">29. As the children of Esau did - They did permit them to
pass quietly by the borders, though not through the heart of their land,
and in their passage the people sold them meat and drink, being it seems
more kind to them than their king would have had them; and therefore
they here ascribe this favour not to the king, though they are now
treating with a king, but to the people, the children of Esau.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p13">30. Hardened his spirit - That is, suffered it to be
hardened.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p14">34. Utterly destroyed - By God's command, these being a
part of those people who were devoted by the Lord of life and death, to
utter destruction for their abominable wickedness.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ii.ii-p15">37. Of Jabbok - That is, beyond Jabbok: for that was the
border of the Ammomites.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="49.19%" prev="ii.vi.ii.ii" next="ii.vi.iii.i" id="ii.vi.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. III" id="ii.vi.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.iii-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="49.19%" prev="ii.vi.iii" next="ii.vi.iii.ii" id="ii.vi.iii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.iii.i-p1">The conquest of Og and his country, ver. 1-11. The
distribution of it to the two tribes and an half, ver. 12-17. On
condition of assisting their brethren, ver. 18-20. Joshua encouraged,
ver. 21- 22. Moses prays that he may go into Canaan, v. 23-25. But is
refused, yet permitted to see it, ver. 26-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="49.19%" prev="ii.vi.iii.i" next="ii.vi.iv" id="ii.vi.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p1">8. On this side Jordan - So it was when Moses wrote this
book; but afterward when Israel passed over Jordan it was called the
land beyond Jordan.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p2">9. Sirion - Elsewhere called Mount Gilead, and Lebanon,
and here Shenir, and Sirion, which several names are given to this one
mountain partly by several people, and partly in regard of several tops
and parts of it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p3">10. All Gilead - Gilead is sometimes taken for all the
Israelites possessions beyond Jordan, and so it comprehends Bashan; but
here for that part of it which lies in and near mount Gilead, and so it
is distinguished from Bashan and Argob.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p4">11. In Rabbath - Where it might now be, either because
the Ammonites in some former battle with Og, had taken it as a spoil: or
because after Og's death, the Ammonites desired to have this monument of
his greatness, and the Israelites permitted them to carry it away to
their chief city. Nine cubits - So his bed was four yards and an half
long, and two yards broad.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p5">14. Unto this day - This must be put among those passages
which were not written by Moses, but added by those holy men, who
digested the books of Moses into this order, and inserted some few
passages to accommodate things to their own time and people.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p6">15. Gilead - That is, the half part of Gilead. To Machir
- That is, unto the children of Machir, son of Manasseh, for Machir was
now dead.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p7">16. Half the valley - Or rather to the middle of the
river: for the word rendered half signifies commonly middle, and the
same Hebrew word means both a valley and a brook or river. And this
sense is agreeable to the truth, that their land extended from Gilead
unto Arnon, and, to speak exactly, to the middle of that river; for as
that river was the border between them and others, so one half of it
belonged to them, as the other half did to others, <scripRef passage="Josh. xii. 2" id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Josh|12|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.12.2">Josh. xii, 2</scripRef>. The same thing is expressed in the same words in the Hebrew
which are here, though our translators render the self- same words
there, from the middle of the river, which here they render, half of the
valley. There the bounds of Sihon's kingdom, which was the same portion
here mentioned as given to Reuben and Gad, are thus described, from
Aroer, which is upon the bank of the river of Arnon, and from the middle
of the river, and from half Gilead, even unto the river Jabbok, which is
the border of the children of Ammon.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p8">17. The plain - The low country towards Jordan. The sea
of the plain - That is, that salt sea, which before that dreadful
conflagration was a goodly plain.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p9">18. You - Namely, the Reubenites and Gadites. All that
are meet - In such number as your our brethren shall judge necessary.
They were in all above an hundred thousand. Forty thousand of them went
over Jordan before their brethren.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p10">23. I besought the Lord - We should allow no desire in
our hearts, which we cannot in faith offer unto God by prayer.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p11">24. Thou hast begun to shew thy servant thy greatness -
Lord, perfect what thou hast begun. The more we see of God's glory in
his works, the more we desire to see. And the more we are affected with
what we have seen of God, the better we are prepared for farther
discoveries.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p12">25. Let me go over - For he supposed God's threatening
might be conditional and reversible, as many others were. That goodly
mountain -Which the Jews not improbably understood of that mountain on
which the temple was to be built. This he seems to call that mountain,
emphatically and eminently, that which was much in Moses's thoughts,
though not in his eye.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p13">28. He shall go over - It was not Moses, but Joshua or
Jesus that was to give the people rest, <scripRef passage="Heb. iv. 8" id="ii.vi.iii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Heb|4|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.4.8">Heb. iv, 8</scripRef>. 'Tis a comfort to those who love mankind, when they are
dying and going off, to see God's work likely to be carried on by other
hands, when they are silent in the dust.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="49.26%" prev="ii.vi.iii.ii" next="ii.vi.iv.i" id="ii.vi.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. IV" id="ii.vi.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.iv-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="49.26%" prev="ii.vi.iv" next="ii.vi.iv.ii" id="ii.vi.iv.i">

<p id="ii.vi.iv.i-p1">An exhortation to obedience, ver. 1-13. A warning against
idolatry, ver. 14-28. A promise upon repentance, ver. 29-40. Cities of
refuge appointed, ver. 41-43. The place where Moses repeated the law,
ver. 44-49.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="49.26%" prev="ii.vi.iv.i" next="ii.vi.v" id="ii.vi.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p1">1. The statutes - The laws which concern the worship and
service of God. The judgments - The laws concerning your duties to men.
So these two comprehend both tables, and the whole law of God.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p2">6. In the sight of the nations - For though the
generality of Heathens in the latter ages, did through inveterate
prejudices condemn the laws of the Hebrew, yet it is certain, the wisest
Heathens did highly approve of them, so that they made use of divers of
them, and translated them into their own laws and constitutions; and
Moses, the giver of these laws, hath been mentioned with great honour
for his wisdom and learning by many of them. And particularly the old
Heathen oracle expressly said, that the Chaldeans or Hebrew, who
worshipped the uncreated God, were the only wise men.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p3">7. So nigh - By glorious miracles, by the pledges of his
special presence, by the operations of his grace, and particularly by
his readiness to hear our prayers, and to give us those succors which we
call upon him for.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p4">8. So righteous - Whereby he implies that the true
greatness of a nation doth not consist in pomp or power, or largeness of
empire, as commonly men think, but in the righteousness of its laws.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p5">10. Thou stoodest - Some of them stood there in their own
persons, though then they were but young, the rest in the loins of their
parents.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p6">11. The midst of heaven - Flaming up into the air, which
is often called heaven.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p7">12. No similitude - No resemblance or representation of
God, whereby either his essence, or properties, or actions were
represented, such as were usual among the Heathens.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p8">14. Statutes and judgments - The ceremonial and judicial
laws which are here distinguished from the moral, or the ten
commandments.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p9">15. In Horeb - God, who in other places and times did
appear in a similitude in the fashion of a man, now in this most solemn
appearance, when he comes to give eternal laws for the direction of the
Israelites in the worship of God, and in their duty to men, purposely
avoids all such representations, to shew that he abhors all worship of
images, or of himself by images of what kind soever, because he is the
invisible God, and cannot be represented by any visible image.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p10">16. Lest ye corrupt yourselves - Your ways, by
worshipping God in a corrupt manner.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p11">19. Driven - Strongly inclined. Which the Lord hath
divided unto all nations - Which are not Gods, but creatures, made not
for the worship, but for the use of men; yea, of the meanest and most
barbarous people under heaven, and therefore cannot without great
absurdity be worshipped, especially by you who are so much advanced
above other nations in wisdom and knowledge, and in this, that you are
my peculiar people.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p12">24. A consuming fire - A just and terrible God, who,
notwithstanding his special relation to thee, will severely punish thee,
if thou provoke him. A jealous God - Who being espoused to thee, will be
highly incensed against thee, (if thou follow after other lovers, or
commit whoredom with idols) and will bear no rival or partner.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p13">28. Ye shall serve Gods - You shall be compelled by men,
and given up by me to idolatry. So that very thing which was your
choice, shall be your punishment: it being just and usual for God to
punish one sin by giving men up to another.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p14">29. If from thence thou seek the Lord - Whatever place we
are in, we may from thence seek him. There is no part of the earth which
has a gulf fixt between it and heaven.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p15">30. In the latter days - In succeeding ages.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p16">32. The one side of heaven - That is, of the earth under
heaven. Ask all the inhabitants of the world.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p17">33. And live - And was not overwhelmed and consumed by
such a glorious appearance.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p18">34. By temptations - Temptations is the general title,
which is explained by the following particulars, signs, and wonders,
&amp;c. which are called temptations, because they were trials both to
the Egyptians and Israelites, whether they would be induced to believe
and obey God or no. By terrors - Raised in the minds of the Egyptians,
or, by terrible things done among them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p19">37. In his sight - Keeping his eye fixed upon him, as the
father doth on his beloved child.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.iv.ii-p20">44. This is the law - More punctually expressed in the
following chapter, to which these words are a preface.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="49.34%" prev="ii.vi.iv.ii" next="ii.vi.v.i" id="ii.vi.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. V" id="ii.vi.v-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.v-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="49.34%" prev="ii.vi.v" next="ii.vi.v.ii" id="ii.vi.v.i">

<p id="ii.vi.v.i-p1">The general intent of the Ten Commandments as a covenant
between God and Israel, ver. 1-5. The Commandments, ver. 6-21. God
writes them, and grants the people's request, that he would speak by
Moses, ver. 22-28. Exhortations to obedience, ver. 29- 33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="49.34%" prev="ii.vi.v.i" next="ii.vi.vi" id="ii.vi.v.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p1">1. All Israel - Namely by their elders, who were to
impart it to the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p2">3. Not with our fathers - Only: but with us, who are all
alive - He saith not, that all who made the covenant at Sinai are now
alive, but this covenant was made with all that are now alive; which is
most true, for it was made with the elders in their persons, and with
the rest in their parents, who covenanted for them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p3">4. Face to face - Personally and immediately, not by the
mouth or ministry of Moses; plainly and certainly, as when two men talk
face to face; freely and familiarly, so as not to overwhelm and confound
you.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p4">5. Between the Lord and you - As a mediator between you,
according to your desire. The word of the Lord - Not the ten
commandments, which God himself uttered, but the following statutes and
judgments.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p5">7. There being little said, concerning the spiritual
sense of the Ten Commandments, in the notes on the twentieth of Exodus,
I think it needful to add a few questions here, which the reader may
answer between God and his own soul. Thou shalt have none other gods
before me - Hast thou worshipped God in spirit and in truth? Hast thou
proposed to thyself no end besides him? Hath he been the end of all thy
actions? Hast thou sought for any other happiness, than the knowledge
and love of God? Dost thou experimentally know the only true God, and
Jesus Christ whom he hath sent? Dost thou love God? Dost thou love him
with all thy heart, with all thy soul, and with all thy strength; so as
to love nothing else but in that manner and degree which tends to
increase thy love of him? Hast thou found happiness in God? Is he the
desire of thine eyes, the joy of thy heart? If not, thou hast other gods
before him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p6">8. Thou shalt not make any graven image - Hast thou not
formed any gross image of God in thy mind? Hast thou always thought of
him as a pure spirit, whom no man hath seen, nor can see? And hast thou
worshipped him with thy body, as well as with thy spirit, seeing both of
them are God's?</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p7">11. Thou shalt not take the name of the Lord thy God in
vain - Hast thou never used the name of God, unless on solemn and
weighty occasions? Hast thou then used it with the deepest awe? Hast
thou duly honoured his word, his ordinances, his ministers? Hast thou
considered all things as they stand in relation to him, and seen God in
all? Hast thou looked upon heaven as God's throne? Up on earth as God's
footstool? On every thing therein as belonging to the great king? On
every creature as full of God?</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p8">12. Keep the sabbath-day, to sanctify it - Dost thou do
no work on this day, which can be done as well on another? Art thou
peculiarly careful on this day, to avoid all conversation, which does
not tend to the knowledge and love of God? Dost thou watch narrowly over
all that are within thy gates, that they too may keep it holy? And dost
thou try every possible means, to bring all men, wherever you are, to do
the same?</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p9">16. honour thy father and mother - Hast thou not been
irreverent or undutiful to either? Hast thou not slighted their advice?
Hast thou cheerfully obeyed all their lawful commands? Hast thou loved
and honoured their persons? Supplied their wants, and concealed their
infirmities? Hast thou wrestled for them with God in prayer? Hast thou
loved and honoured thy prince, and avoided as fire all speaking evil of
the ruler of thy people? Have ye that are servants done all things as
unto Christ? Not with eye-service, but in singleness of heart? Have ye
who are masters, behaved as parents to your servants, with all
gentleness and affection? Have ye all obeyed them that watch over your
souls, and esteemed them highly in love for their work's sake?</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p10">17. Thou shalt not kill - Have you not tempted any one,
to what might shorten his life? Have you tempted none to intemperance?
Have you suffered none to be intemperate under your roof, or in your
company? Have you done all you could in every place, to prevent
intemperance of all kinds! Are you guilty of no degree of self-murder?
Do you never eat or drink any thing because you like it, although you
have reason to believe, it is prejudicial to your health? Have you
constantly done whatever you had reason to believe was conducive to it?
Have you not hated your neighbour in your heart? Have you reproved him
that committed sin in your sight? If not, you have in God's account
hated him, seeing you suffered sin upon him. Have you loved all men as
your own soul? As Christ loved us? Have you done unto all men, as in
like circumstances, you would they should do to you? Have you done all
in your power to help your neighbours, enemies as well as friends? Have
you laboured to deliver every soul you could from sin and misery? Have
you shewed that you loved all men as yourself, by a constant, earnest
endeavour, to fill all places with holiness and happiness, with the
knowledge and love of God?</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p11">18. Neither shalt thou commit adultery - If thou hast not
been guilty of any act of uncleanness, hath thy heart conceived no
unclean thought? Hast thou not looked on a woman so as to lust after
her? Hast thou not betrayed thy own soul to temptation, by eating and
drinking to the full, by needless familiarities, by foolish talking, by
levity of dress or behaviour? Hast thou used all the means which
scripture and reason suggest, to prevent every kind and degree of
unchastity? Hast thou laboured, by watching, fasting, and prayer, to
possess thy vessel in sanctification and honour?</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p12">19. Neither shalt thou steal - Have you seriously
considered, that these houses, lands, money, or goods, which you are
used to call your own, are not your own, but belong to another, even
God? Have you ever considered, that God is the sole proprietor of heaven
and earth? The true owner of every thing therein? Have you considered,
that he has only lent them to you? That you are but a steward of your
Lord's goods? And that he has told you expressly the uses and purposes
for which he intrusts you with them? Namely, for the furnishing first
yourselves, and then as many others as you can, with the things needful
for life and godliness? Have you considered, that you have no right at
all, to apply any part of them to any other purpose? And that if you do,
you are as much a robber of God, as any can be a robber of you?</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p13">20. Neither shalt thou bear false witness against thy
neighbour - Have you not been guilty of evil-speaking? Of needlessly
repeating the real fault of your neighbour? If I see a man do an evil
thing, and tell it to another, unless from a full and clear conviction,
that it is necessary to mention it just then, for the glory of God, the
safety or good of some other person, or for the benefit of him that hath
done amiss; and unless I then do it only so far, as is necessary to
these ends, that is evil-speaking. O beware of this! It is scattering
abroad arrows, fire-brands, and death.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p14">21. Neither shalt thou covet any thing that is thy
neighbour's - The plain meaning of this is, thou shalt not desire any
thing that is not thy own, any thing which thou hast not. Indeed why
shouldst thou? God hath given thee whatever tends to thy one end,
holiness. Thou canst not deny it, without making him a liar: and: when
any thing else will tend thereto, he will give thee that also. There is
therefore no room to desire any thing which thou hast not. Thou hast
already every thing that is really good for thee, wouldst thou have more
money, more pleasure, more praise still? Why this is not good for thee.
God has told thee so, by withholding it from thee. O give thyself up to
his wise and gracious disposal!</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p15">22. Out of the midst of the fire, of the cloud, and of
the thick darkness - That was a dispensation of terror, designed to make
the gospel of grace the more welcome, and to be a specimen of the
terrors of the judgment-day. He added no more - He ceased for that time
to speak immediately, and with that loud voice unto the people; for the
rest were delivered to Moses, and by him communicated unto them. This he
did to shew the preeminence of that law above the rest, and its
everlasting obligation.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p16">25. Why should we die? - For though God hath for this
season kept us alive, yet we shall never be able to endure any further
discourse from him in such a terrible manner, but shall certainly sink
under the burden of it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p17">26. Flesh - Is here put for man in his frail,
corruptible, and mortal state.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.v.ii-p18">29. O that there were such an heart in them! - A heart to
fear God, and keep his commandments forever! The God of heaven is truly
and earnestly desirous of the salvation of poor sinners. He has given
abundant proof that he is so: he gives us time and space to repent; by
his mercies invites us to repentance, and waiteth to be gracious: has
sent his son to redeem us, published a general offer of pardon, promised
his spirit to those that pray for him; and has said, yea and sworn, that
he hath no pleasure in the death of a sinner!</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="49.50%" prev="ii.vi.v.ii" next="ii.vi.vi.i" id="ii.vi.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. VI" id="ii.vi.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.vi-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="49.50%" prev="ii.vi.vi" next="ii.vi.vi.ii" id="ii.vi.vi.i">

<p id="ii.vi.vi.i-p1">A persuasive to obedience, ver. 1-3. The first truth, God
is One, the first duty, to love him, ver. 4, 5. The means hereto, ver.
6-9. A caution not to forget God in prosperity, ver. 10-13. Not to
worship idols, or tempt God, ver. 14-16. Exhortation to obedience, ver.
17-19. And to teach their children, ver. 20-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="49.51%" prev="ii.vi.vi.i" next="ii.vi.vii" id="ii.vi.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p1">5. And thou shalt love the Lord thy God with all thine
heart - And is this only an external commandment? Can any then say, that
the Sinai - covenant was merely external? With all thy heart - With an
entire love. He is One; therefore our hearts must be united in his love.
And the whole stream of our affections must run toward Him. O that this
love of God may be shed abroad in our hearts.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p2">7. Teach them diligently - Hebrew. whet, or sharpen them,
so as they may pierce deep into their hearts. This metaphor signifies
the manner of instructing them, that it is to be done diligently,
earnestly, frequently, discreetly.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p3">8. Thou shalt bind them - Thou shalt give all diligence,
and use all means to keep them in thy remembrance, as men often bind
something upon their hands, or put it before their eyes to prevent
forgetfulness of a thing which they much desire to remember.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p4">13. Shalt swear by his name - When thou hast a call and
just cause to swear, not by idols, or any creatures.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p5">15. Among you - Hebrew. In the midst of you, to see and
observe all your ways and your turnings aside to other Gods.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p6">16. Ye shall not tempt - Not provoke him, as the
following instance explains. Sinners, especially presumptuous sinners,
are said to tempt God, that is, to make a trial of God, whether he be,
so wise as to see their sins, so just and true and powerful as to take
vengeance on them, concerning which they are very apt to doubt because
of the present impunity and prosperity of many such persons.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p7">17. Ye diligently keep - Negligence will ruin us: but we
cannot be saved without diligence.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p8">25. It shall be our righteousness - Hebrew. Righteousness
shall be to us. We shall be owned and pronounced by God to be righteous
and holy persons, if we sincerely obey him, otherwise we shall be
declared to be unrighteous and ungodly. Or, mercy shall be to us, or
with us. For as the Hebrew word rendered righteousness is very often put
for mercy, (as <scripRef passage="Psalm xxiv. 5" id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|24|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.24.5">Psalm xxiv, 5</scripRef>; xxxvi, 10; li, 14 <scripRef passage="Prov. x. 2" id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p8.2" parsed="|Prov|10|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.10.2">Prov. x, 2</scripRef>; xi, 4 <scripRef passage="Dan. ix. 16" id="ii.vi.vi.ii-p8.3" parsed="|Dan|9|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.9.16">Dan. ix, 16</scripRef>) so this sense seems best to agree both with the scripture
use of this phrase, (in which righteousness, seldom or never, but grace
or mercy frequently, is said to be to us or with us) and with the
foregoing verse and argument God, saith he, chap. v, 24, commanded these
things for our good, that he might preserve us alive, as it is this day.
And, saith he in this verse, this is not all; for as he hath done us
good, so he will go on to do us more and more good, and God's mercy
shall be to us, or with us, in the remainder of our lives, and forever,
if we observe these commandments.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="49.55%" prev="ii.vi.vi.ii" next="ii.vi.vii.i" id="ii.vi.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. VII" id="ii.vi.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.vii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="49.55%" prev="ii.vi.vii" next="ii.vi.vii.ii" id="ii.vi.vii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.vii.i-p1">A command to destroy the Canaanites, with all pertaining
to their idols, ver. 1-5. And to obey God, considering their relation to
him, ver. 6-11. Promises to the obedient, ver. 12-15. A repetition of
the command, utterly to destroy the Canaanites, with all the monuments
of their idolatry, ver. 16-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="49.56%" prev="ii.vi.vii.i" next="ii.vi.viii" id="ii.vi.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p1">1. Seven nations - There were ten in <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 19-21" id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|15|19|15|21" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.19-Gen.15.21">Gen. xv, 19-21</scripRef>. But this being some hundreds of years after, it is not
strange if three of them were either destroyed by foreign or domestick
wars, or by cohabitation and marriage united with, and swallowed up in
the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p2">4. To serve other Gods - That is, there is manifest
danger of apostacy and idolatry from such matches. Which reason doth
both limit the law to such of these as are unconverted (otherwise Salmon
married Rahab, <scripRef passage="Matt. i. 5" id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Matt|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.1.5">Matt. i, 5</scripRef>) and enlarge it to other idolatrous nations, as appears from
<scripRef passage="1 Kings xi. 2" id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|1Kgs|11|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.11.2">1 Kings xi, 2</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Ezra ix. 2" id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p2.3" parsed="|Ezra|9|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.9.2">Ezra ix, 2</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Neh. xiii. 23" id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p2.4" parsed="|Neh|13|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.13.23">Neh.
xiii, 23</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p3">5. Their graves - Which idolaters planted about the
temples and altars of their Gods. Hereby God designed to take away
whatsoever might bring their idolatry to remembrance, or occasion the
reviving of it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p4">7. The fewest - To wit, at that time when God first
declared his choice of you for his peculiar people, which was done to
Abraham. For Abraham had but one son concerned in this choice and
covenant, namely, Isaac, and that was in his hundredth year; and Isaac
was sixty years old ere he had a child, and then had only two children;
and though Jacob had twelve sons, it was a long time before they made
any considerable increase. Nor do we read of any great multiplication of
them 'till after Joseph's death.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p5">8. The Lord loved you - It was his free choice without
any cause or motive on your part.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p6">10. Them that hate him - Not only those who hate him
directly and properly, (for so did few or none of the Israelites to whom
he here speaks,) but those who hate him by construction and consequence;
those who hate and oppose his people, and word, those who wilfully
persist in the breach of God's commandments. To their face - That is,
openly, and so as they shall see it, and not be able to avoid it. Slack
- So as to delay it beyond the fit time or season for vengeance, yet
withal he is long-suffering, and slow to anger.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p7">12. The covenant and the mercy - That is, the covenant of
mercy, which he out of his own mere grace made with them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p8">13. He will love thee - He will continue to love thee,
and to manifest his love to thee.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p9">15. The diseases of Egypt - Such as the Egyptians were
infected with, either commonly, or miraculously. It seems to refer not
only to the plagues of Egypt, but to some other epidemic disease, which
they remembered to have prevailed among the Egyptians, and by which God
had chastised them for their national sins. Diseases are God's servants,
which go where he sends them, and do what he bids them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p10">19. The temptations - The trials and exercises of thy
faith and obedience to my commands.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p11">24. No man shall stand - This promise is made upon
condition of their performance of their duty, which they neglecting,
justly lose the benefit of it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.vii.ii-p12">25. The silver or gold - Wherewith the idols are covered
or adorned, nor consequently any other of their ornaments. This he
commands to shew his utter detestation of idolatry, and to cut off all
occasions of it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="49.61%" prev="ii.vi.vii.ii" next="ii.vi.viii.i" id="ii.vi.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. VIII" id="ii.vi.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.viii-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="49.61%" prev="ii.vi.viii" next="ii.vi.viii.ii" id="ii.vi.viii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.viii.i-p1">An exhortation to obedience, in consideration of past and
promised mercies, ver. 1-9. A caution not to forget God in prosperity,
ver. 10-18. A threatening, in case of apostacy, ver. 19, 20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="49.61%" prev="ii.vi.viii.i" next="ii.vi.ix" id="ii.vi.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.viii.ii-p1">1. Live - Live comfortably and happily.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.viii.ii-p2">2. All the way - All the events which befell three in the
way, the miraculous protections, deliverances, provisions, instructions
which God gave thee; and withal the frequent and severe punishments of
thy disobedience. To know - That thou mightest discover to thyself and
others that infidelity, inconstancy, hypocrisy, and perverseness, which
lay hid in thy heart; the discovery whereof was of singular use both to
them, and to the church of God in all succeeding ages. It is good for us
likewise to remember all the ways both of God's providence and grace, by
which he has led us hitherto through the wilderness, that we may trust
him, and cheerfully serve him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.viii.ii-p3">3. By every word - That is, by every or any thing which
God appoints for this end, how unlikely so-ever it may seem to be for
nourishment; seeing it is not the creature, but only God's command and
blessing upon it, that makes it sufficient for the support of life.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.viii.ii-p4">5. As a man chastiseth his son - That is, unwillingly,
being constrained by necessity; moderately, in judgment remembering
mercy; and for thy reformation not thy destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.viii.ii-p5">7. Depths - Deep wells or springs, or lakes, which were
numerous and large.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.viii.ii-p6">9. Whose stones are iron - Where are mines of iron in a
manner as plentiful as stones, and upon which travelers must tread, as
in other parts they do upon stones.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.viii.ii-p7">10. Bless the Lord - Solemnly praise him for thy food;
which is a debt both of gratitude and justice, because it is from his
providence and favour that thou receivest both thy food and refreshment
and strength by it. The more unworthy and absurd is that too common
profaneness of them, who, professing to believe a God, from whom all
their comforts come, grudge to own him at their meals, either by
desiring his blessing before them, or by offering due praise to God
after them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.viii.ii-p8">14. Lifted up - As if thou didst receive and enjoy these
things, either, by thy owns wisdom, and valour, and industry, or for thy
own merit.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.viii.ii-p9">16. That he might humble thee - By keeping thee in a
constant dependence upon him for every day's food, and convincing thee
what an impotent, helpless creature thou art, having nothing whereon to
subsist, and being supported wholly by the alms of divine goodness from
day to day. The mercies of God, if duly considered, are as powerful a
mean to humble us as the greatest afflictions, because they increase our
debts to God, and manifest our dependance upon him, and by making God
great, they make us little in our own eyes. To do thee good - That is,
that after he hath purged and prepared thee by afflictions, thou mayest
receive and enjoy his blessings with less disadvantage, whilst by the
remembrance of former afflictions. thou art made thankful for them, and
more cautious not to abuse them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="49.66%" prev="ii.vi.viii.ii" next="ii.vi.ix.i" id="ii.vi.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. IX" id="ii.vi.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.ix-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="49.66%" prev="ii.vi.ix" next="ii.vi.ix.ii" id="ii.vi.ix.i">

<p id="ii.vi.ix.i-p1">A promise of Canaan, ver. 1-3. A caution, not to ascribe
this to their own merit, ver. 4-6. A rehearsal of their various
rebellions, ver. 7-24. and of Moses's intercession for them, ver.
25-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="49.67%" prev="ii.vi.ix.i" next="ii.vi.x" id="ii.vi.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p1">1. Hear, O Israel - This seems to be a new discourse,
delivered at some distance of time from the former, probably on the next
sabbath-day. This day - That is, shortly, within a little time, the word
day being often put for time. Nations - That is, the land of those
nations. Mightier than thyself - This he adds, that they might not trust
to their own strength, but rely upon God's help for the destroying them,
and, after the work was done, might ascribe the glory of it to God
alone, and not to themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p2">2. Who can stand - This seems to be a proverb used in
those times.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p3">5. Not for thy righteousness - Neither for thy upright
heart, nor holy life, which are the two things which God above all
things regards. And consequently he excludes all merit. And surely they
who did not deserve this earthly Canaan, could not merit the kingdom of
glory. To perform the word - To shew my faithfulness in accomplishing
that promise which I graciously made and confirmed with my oath.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p4">6. Stiff-necked - Rebellious and perverse, and so
destitute of all pretense of righteousness. And thus our gaining
possession of the heavenly Canaan, must be ascribed to God's power, not
our own might, and to God's Grace, not our own merit. In him we must
glory.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p5">8. In Horeb - When your miraculous deliverance out of
Egypt was fresh in memory; when God had but newly manifested himself to
you in so stupendous and dreadful a manner, and had taken you into
covenant with himself, when God was actually conferring farther mercies
upon you.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p6">10. With the finger of God - Immediately and
miraculously, which was done not only to procure the greater reverence
to the law, but also to signify, that it is the work of God alone to
write this law upon the tables of men's hearts. In the day of the
assembly - That is, when the people were gathered by God's command to
the bottom of Mount Sinai, to hear and receive God's ten commandments
from his own mouth.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p7">14. Let me alone! - Stop me not by thy intercession.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p8">17. I brake them before your eyes - Not by an unbridled
passion, but in zeal for God's honour, and by the direction of God's
spirit, to signify to tine people, that the covenant between God and
them contained in those tables was broken and they were now cast out of
God's favour, and could expect nothing from him but fiery
indignation.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p9">18. I fell down - In a way of humiliation and
supplication, on your behalf.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p10">21. Into the brook - That there might be no monument or
remembrance of it left.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p11">25. I fell down forty days - The same as were mentioned
before, ver. 18, as appears by comparing this with Exodus, where this
history is more fully related, and where this is said to be done twice
only.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p12">26. Through thy greatness - Through the greatness of thy
power, which appeared most eminently in that work.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p13">27. Thy servants - That is, the promise made and sworn to
thy servants.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.ix.ii-p14">29. Thy people - Whom thou hast chosen to thyself out of
all mankind, and publickly owned them for thine, and hast purchased and
redeemed them from the Egyptians.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="49.72%" prev="ii.vi.ix.ii" next="ii.vi.x.i" id="ii.vi.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. X" id="ii.vi.x-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.x-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="49.72%" prev="ii.vi.x" next="ii.vi.x.ii" id="ii.vi.x.i">

<p id="ii.vi.x.i-p1">God's mercy, in renewing the two tables, ver. 1-5. In
leading Israel forward, and chusing the tribe of Levi for his own, ver.
6-9. In accepting the intercession as Moses, ver. 10-11. An exhortation
to fear, love, and serve God, ver. 12-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="49.72%" prev="ii.vi.x.i" next="ii.vi.xi" id="ii.vi.x.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p1">2. I will write on the tables - Tho' the tables were
broken, because they broke his commandment, they were now renewed, in
proof that his wrath was turned away. And thus God's writing his law in
our inward parts, is the surest proof of our reconciliation to him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p2">6. This following history comes in manifestly by way of
parenthesis, as may appear from ver. 10, where he returns to his former
discourse; and it seems to be here inserted as an evidence of God's
gracious answer to Moses's prayers, and of his reconciliation to the
people, notwithstanding their late and great provocation. For, saith he,
after this they proceeded by God's guidance in their journeys, and
though Aaron died in one of them, yet God made up that breach, and
Eleazar came in his place, and ministered as priest, one branch of which
office was to intercede for the people.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p3">8. At that time - About that time, that is, when I was
come down from the mount, as was said, ver. 5. To stand before the Lord
- A phrase used concerning the prophets, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xvii. 1" id="ii.vi.x.ii-p3.1" parsed="|1Kgs|17|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.17.1">1 Kings xvii, 1</scripRef>; xviii, 15, this being the posture of ministers. Hence the
angels are said to stand, <scripRef passage="2Chr xviii. 18" id="ii.vi.x.ii-p3.2" parsed="|2Chr|18|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.18.18">2Chr xviii, 18</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Luke i. 19" id="ii.vi.x.ii-p3.3" parsed="|Luke|1|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1.19">Luke i, 19</scripRef>. To bless - The people, by performance of those holy
ministrations for the people, and giving those instructions to them, to
which God's blessing was promised; and this they did in God's name, that
is, by command, and commission from him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p4">9. The Lord is his inheritance - That is, the Lord's
portion, namely, tithes and offerings, which belong to God, are given by
him to the Levites for their subsistence, from generation to
generation.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p5">11. Take thy journey before the people - 'Twas fit that
he who had saved them from ruin by his intercession, should have the
conduct and command of them. And herein he was a type of Christ, who, as
he ever lives to make intercession for us, so has all power in heaven
and in earth.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p6">12. What doth he require - By way of duty and gratitude
for such amazing mercies.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p7">14. The heaven - The airy and starry heaven. The heaven
of heavens - The highest or third heaven, called the heaven of heavens
for its eminency. All that therein is - With all creatures and all men,
which being all his, he might have chosen what nation he pleased to be
his people.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p8">15. To love them - He shews that God had no particular
obligation to their fathers, any more than to other persons or people,
all being equally his creatures, and that his choice of them out of and
above all others, proceeded only from God's good pleasure.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p9">16. Circumcise - Rest not in your bodily circumcision,
but seriously set upon that substantial work which is signified thereby:
cleanse your hearts from all filthiness and superfluity of naughtiness,
fitly compared to the foreskin, which if not cut off, made persons
profane, unclean and odious in the sight of God.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p10">17. Regardeth not persons - Whether Jews or Gentiles, but
deals justly and equally with all sorts of men; and as whosoever fears
and obeys him shall be accepted, so all incorrigible transgressors shall
be severely punished, and you no less than other people: therefore do
not flatter yourselves as if God would bear with your sins because of
his particular kindness to you or to your fathers.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p11">18. He doth execute - That is, plead their cause, and
give them right against their potent adversaries, and therefore he
expects you should do so too.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p12">20. To him shalt thou cleave - With firm confidence, true
affection, and constant obedience.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.x.ii-p13">21. Thy praise - The object and matter of thy praise, as <scripRef passage="Exod. xv. 2" id="ii.vi.x.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Exod|15|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.15.2">Exod. xv,
2</scripRef>, whom thou shouldest ever praise.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="49.79%" prev="ii.vi.x.ii" next="ii.vi.xi.i" id="ii.vi.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XI" id="ii.vi.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xi-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="49.79%" prev="ii.vi.xi" next="ii.vi.xi.ii" id="ii.vi.xi.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xi.i-p1">Moses exhorts them to obedience by rehearsing God's
works, ver. 1-7. By describing the goodness of the land, ver. 8-12. By
promises and threats, ver. 13-17. An exhortation to teach their
children, closed with a promise, ver. 18-25. A blessing and a curse,
ver. 26-32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="49.79%" prev="ii.vi.xi.i" next="ii.vi.xii" id="ii.vi.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p1">2. Know - That is, acknowledge and consider it with
diligence and thankfulness.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p2">4. Unto this day - The effect of which destruction
continueth to this day, in their weakness and fear, and our safety from
their farther attempts against us.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p3">7. Your eyes have seen - All of them had seen some, and
some of them had seen all the great things done in Egypt and at the Red-
sea, and in the Wilderness. What our eyes have seen, especially in our
early days, should be improved by us long after.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p4">10. With thy foot - That is, with great pains and labour
of thy feet, partly by going up and down to fetch water and disperse it,
and partly by digging furrows with thy foot, and using engines for
distributing the water, which engines they thrust with their feet. For
tho' the river Nile did once in a year overflow the grounds, and made
them fruitful, yet often it failed them, at least in part, and then they
were put to great pains about their ground. And when it did overflow
sufficiently, and left its mud upon the earth, yet that mud was in a
little time hardened, and needed another watering, and much digging and
labour both of the hand and feet, especially in places more remote from
that river; which inconvenience Canaan was free from.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p5">11. Of hills and valleys - And therefore much more
healthful than Egypt was, which as it was enriched, so it was annoyed
with the Nile, which overflowed the land in summer time, and thereby
made the country both unpleasant and unhealthful. And health being the
greatest of all outward blessings, Canaan must therefore needs be a more
desirable habitation than Egypt. The rain of heaven - Which is more
easy, being given thee without thy charge or pains; more sweet and
pleasant, not hindering thy going abroad upon thy occasions, as the
overflow of the Nile did, whereby the Egyptians were confined in a great
measure to their houses; more safe and healthful, being free from that
mud which attends upon the waters of the Nile; and more certain too, the
former and the latter rain being promised to be given to them in their
several seasons, upon condition of their obedience, which condition,
tho' it may seem a clog and inconvenience, yet indeed was a great
benefit, that by their own necessities and interest they might be
obliged to that obedience, upon which their happiness depended both for
this life and the next.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p6">12. Careth for - In a special manner watering it
immediately as it were by his own hand, without man's help, and giving
peculiar blessings to it, which Egypt enjoys not. To the end of the year
- To give it the rain, and other blessings proper to the several
seasons. But all these mercies, and the fruitfulness of the land
consequent upon them, were suspended upon their disobedience. And
therefore it is not at all strange that some later writers, describe the
land of Canaan as a barren soil, which is, so far from affording ground
to question the authority of the scriptures, that it doth much more
confirm it, this, being an effect of that threatning that God would turn
a fruitful land into barrenness for the wickedness of these that dwell
in it, <scripRef passage="Psalm cvii. 34" id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Ps|107|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.107.34">Psalm cvii, 34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p7">14. The ruin of your land - Which is, proper to your
land, not common to Egypt, where, as all authors agree, there is little
rain. The first rain fell in seed time, to make the corn spring, the
other a little before harvest, to ripen it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p8">15. I will send grass in thy fields - So godliness has
here the promise of the life which now is. But the favour of God puts
gladness into the heart, more than the increase of corn, wine and
oil.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p9">17. Shut up the heaven - Which is compared sometimes to a
great store-house wherein God lays up his treasures of rain, <scripRef passage="Job xxxviii. 22" id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Job|38|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.38.22">Job xxxviii,
22</scripRef>, the doors whereof God is said to open when he gives rain,
and to shut when he witholds it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p10">18. Lay up - Let us all observe these three rules,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p11">1. Let our hearts be filled with the word
of God. Lay up these words in your hearts, as in a store-house, to be
used upon all occasions.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p12">2. Let our eyes be fixed upon the word of
God: Bind them for a sign upon your hand, which is always in view, and
as frontlets between your eyes, which you cannot avoid the sight of.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p13">3. Let our tongues be employed about the
word of God, especially with our children, who must be taught this, as
far more needful than the rules of decency, or the calling they are to
live by.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p14">21. As the days of heaven - As long as the heaven keeps
its place and continues its influences upon earth.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p15">24. Every place - Not absolutely, as the Rabbins fondly
conceit, but in the promised land, as it is restrained in the following
words; either by possession, or by dominion, namely, upon condition of
your obedience. The wilderness - Of Sin, on the south-side. To Lebanon -
Which was on the north border. Euphrates - On the east. So far the right
of dominion extended, but that their sins cut them short: and so far
Solomon extended his dominion. The uttermost sea - The western or
midland sea.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p16">26. I set before you - I propose them to your choice.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p17">28. Which ye have not known - Which you have no
acquaintance with, nor experience of their power, or wisdom, or
goodness, as you have had of mine.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p18">29. Put - Hebrew. Thou shalt give, that is, speak or
pronounce, or cause to be pronounced. So the word to give is used, chap.
xiii, 1, 2<scripRef passage="Job xxxvi. 3" id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Job|36|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.36.3">Job xxxvi, 3</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Prov. ix. 9" id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p18.2" parsed="|Prov|9|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.9.9">Prov. ix, 9</scripRef>. This is, more particularly expressed, chap. xxvii, 12,
13.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p19">30. Over against - Looking toward Gilgal, tho' at some
considerable distance from it. Beside the plains of Moreh - This was one
of the first places that Abram came to in Canaan. So that in sending
them thither to hear the blessing and the curse, they were minded of the
promise made to Abram in that very place, <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 6, 7" id="ii.vi.xi.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Gen|12|6|12|7" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.6-Gen.12.7">Gen. xii, 6, 7</scripRef>.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="49.89%" prev="ii.vi.xi.ii" next="ii.vi.xii.i" id="ii.vi.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XII" id="ii.vi.xii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="49.89%" prev="ii.vi.xii" next="ii.vi.xii.ii" id="ii.vi.xii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xii.i-p1">A command, to destroy all relicks of idolatry, ver. 1-3.
To worship God in his own place, and according to his own appointment,
ver. 4-14. A permission to eat flesh, but not blood, ver. 15, 16.
Directions to eat the tithe in the holy place, and to take care of the
Levite, ver. 17-19. A farther permission to eat flesh, but not blood,
ver. 20-25. A direction to eat holy things in the holy place, ver.
26-28. Farther cautions against idolatry, ver. 20-32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="49.90%" prev="ii.vi.xii.i" next="ii.vi.xiii" id="ii.vi.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p1">2. All the places - Temples, chapels, altars, groves, as
appears from other scriptures. Green-tree - As the Gentiles consecrated
divers trees to their false gods, so they worshipped these under
them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p2">3. Pillars - Upon which their images were set. Names -
That is, all the memorials of them, and the very names given to the
places from the idols.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p3">4. Not do so - That is, not worship him in several
places, mountains, and groves.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p4">5. To put his name there - That is, to set up his worship
there, and which he shall call by his name, as his house, or his
dwelling- place; namely, where the ark should be, the tabernacle, or
temple: which was first Shiloh, and then Jerusalem. There is not one
precept in all the law of Moses, so largely inculcated as this, to bring
all their sacrifices to that one altar. And how significant is, that
appointment? They must keep to one place, in token of their belief. That
there is one God, and one Mediator between God and man. It not only
served to keep up the notion of the unity of the godhead, but the one
only way of approach to God and communion with him in and by his
son.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p5">6. Thither bring your burnt-offerings - Which were wisely
appropriated to that one place, for the security of the true religion,
and for the prevention of idolatry and superstition, which might
otherwise more easily have crept in: and to signify that their
sacrifices were not accepted for their own worth, but by God's gracious,
appointment, and for the sake of God's altar, by which they were
sanctified, and for the sake of Christ, whom the altar manifestly
represented. Your heave-offerings - That is, your first-fruits, of
corn, and wine, and oil, and other fruits. And these are called the
heave-offerings of their hand, because the offerer was first to take
these into his hands, and to heave them before the Lord, and then to
give them to the priest. Your free-will-offerings - Even your voluntary
oblations, which were not due by my prescription, but only by your own
choice: you may chuse what kind of offering you please to offer, but not
the place where you shall offer them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p6">7. There - Not in the most holy place, wherein only the
priests might eat, but in places allowed to the people for this, end in
the holy city. Ye shall eat - Your part of the things mentioned, ver. 6.
Before the Lord - In the place of God's presence, where God's sanctuary
shall be.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p7">8. Here - Where the inconveniency of the place, and the
uncertainty of our abode, would not permit exact order in sacrifices and
feasts and ceremonies, which therefore God was then pleased to dispense
with; but, saith he, he will not do so there. Right in his own eyes -
Not that universal liberty was given to all persons to worship how they
listed; but in many things their unsettled condition gave opportunity to
do so.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p8">11. His name - His majesty and glory, his worship and
service, his, special and gracious presence. Your choice vows - Hebrew.
the choice of your vows, that is, your select or chosen vows; so called,
because things offered for vows, were to be perfect, whereas defective
creatures were accepted in free-will-offerings.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p9">12. Your daughters - Hence it appears, that though the
males only were obliged to appear before God in their solemn feasts, yet
the women also were permitted to come.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p10">13. Thy burnt-offerings - Nor the other things mentioned
above, this one and most eminent kind being put for all the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p11">17. Within thy gates - That is, in your private
habitations, here opposed to the place of God's worship.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p12">20. Enlarge thy border - Which will make it impossible to
bring all the cattle thou usest to the tabernacle.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p13">21. If the place be too far - Being obliged to carry
their sacrifices to the place of worship, they might think themselves
obliged to carry their other cattle thither to be killed. They are
therefore released from all such obligations, and left at liberty to
kill them at home, whether they lived nearer that place, or farther from
it; only the latter is here mentioned, as being the matter of the
scruple. As I have commanded - In such a manner as the blood may be
poured forth.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p14">22. As the roe-buck - As common or unhallowed food, tho'
they be of the same kind with the sacrifices which are offered to God.
The unclean - Because there was, no holiness in such meat for which the
unclean might be excluded from it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p15">27. The flesh - Excepting what shall be burned to God's,
honour, and given to the priest according to his appointment.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xii.ii-p16">30. By following them - By following the example they
left, when their persons are destroyed.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="49.98%" prev="ii.vi.xii.ii" next="ii.vi.xiii.i" id="ii.vi.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XIII" id="ii.vi.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xiii-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="49.98%" prev="ii.vi.xiii" next="ii.vi.xiii.ii" id="ii.vi.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.i-p1">Enticers to idolatry to be stoned, ver. 1-11. Idolatrous
cities to be entirely destroyed, ver. 12-18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="49.98%" prev="ii.vi.xiii.i" next="ii.vi.xiv" id="ii.vi.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p1">1. A dreamer of dreams - One that pretends God hath
revealed himself to him by visions or dreams. Giveth a sign or wonder -
That is, shall foretell some strange and wonderful thing.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p2">3. Thou shalt not hearken to that prophet - Not receive
his doctrine, though the sign come to pass. For although when such a
sign or wonder foretold did not follow or come to pass, it was a sign of
a false prophet, yet when it did come to pass, it was no sufficient sign
of a true one, especially, in such a case. There are many things, which
may be wrought by evil spirits, God so permitting it for wise and just
reasons, not only for the trial of the good, but also for the punishment
of ungodly men. Proveth you - That is, trieth your faith and love and
obedience. To know - Namely, judicially, or in a publick manner, so as
both you and others may know and see it, that so the justice of his
judgments upon you may be more evident and glorious.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p3">5. To thrust - This phrase notes the great force and
power of seducers to corrupt men's minds. So shalt thou put the evil
away - Thou shalt remove the guilt, by removing the guilty.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p4">6. The son of thy mother - This is added, to restrain the
signification of the word brother, which is often used generally for one
near a-kin, and to express the nearness of the relation, the mother's,
side being usually the ground of the most fervent affection. Thy
daughter - Thy piety must overcome both thy affection, and thy
compassion to the weaker sex. The father and mother are here omitted,
because they are sufficiently contained in the former examples.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p5">8. Conceal him - That is, smother his fault, hide or
protect his person, but shalt accuse him to the magistrate, and demand
justice upon him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p6">9. Thou shalt kill him - Not privately, which pretense
would have opened the door to innumerable murders, but by procuring his
death by the sentence of the magistrate. Thou shalt cast the first stone
at him, as the witness was to do.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p7">13. Children of Belial - It signifies properly persons
without yoke, vile and wretched miscreants, lawless and rebellious, that
will suffer no restraint, that neither fear God, nor reverence man. From
among you - That is, from your church and religion. It notes a
separation from them, not in place (as appears by their partnership with
their fellow citizens both in the sin and punishment) but in heart,
doctrine and worship.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p8">14. Inquire - This is, meant of the magistrate, to whose
office this properly belongs, and of whom he continues to speak in the
same manner, thou, ver. 15, 16. The Jewish writers say, the defection of
a city is to be tried by the great sanhedrim. If it appear, that they
are thrust away to idolatry, they send two learned men, to admonish
them. If they repent, all is well: is not, all Israel must go up and
execute this sentence. Tho' we do not find this law put in execution, in
all the history of the Jewish church, yet for neglecting the execution
of it on inferior cities, God himself by the army of the Chaldeans,
executed it on Jerusalem, the head city, which was utterly destroyed,
and lay in ruins for seventy years.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p9">15. The inhabitants - Namely, all that are guilty, not
the innocent part, such as disowned this apostacy, who doubtless by
choice, at least upon warning, would come out of so wicked a place.
Utterly - The very same punishment which was, inflicted upon the cities
of the cursed Canaanites, to whom having made themselves equal in sin,
it is but just God should equal them in punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p10">16. For the Lord - For the satisfaction of God's justice,
the maintainance of his honour and authority, and the pacification of
his offended majesty. It shall not be built - It shall be an eternal
monument of God's justice, and terror to after ages.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiii.ii-p11">17. Multiply thee - So thou shalt have no loss of thy
numbers by cutting off so many people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="50.05%" prev="ii.vi.xiii.ii" next="ii.vi.xiv.i" id="ii.vi.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XIV" id="ii.vi.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xiv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="50.05%" prev="ii.vi.xiv" next="ii.vi.xiv.ii" id="ii.vi.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xiv.i-p1">Directions, concerning mourning, ver. 1, 2. Concerning
clean and unclean meats, ver. 3-21. Concerning tithes, ver. 29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="50.05%" prev="ii.vi.xiv.i" next="ii.vi.xv" id="ii.vi.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xiv.ii-p1">1. Of the Lord - Whom therefore you must not disparage by
unworthy or unbecoming practices. Ye shall not cut yourselves - Which
were the practices of idolaters, both in the worship of their idols, in
their funerals, and upon occasion of public calamities. Is not this like
a parent's charge to his little children, playing with knives, "Do not
cut yourselves!" This is, the intention of those commands, which obliges
us to deny ourselves. The meaning is, Do yourselves no harm! And as this
also is, the design of cross providences, to remove from us those things
by which we are in danger of doing ourselves harm.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiv.ii-p2">3. Abominable - Unclean and forbidden by me, which
therefore should be abominable to you.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiv.ii-p3">22. All the increase - This is to be understood of the
second tithes, which seem to be the same with the tithes of the first
year, mentioned ver. 28.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiv.ii-p4">25. In thine hand - That is, in a bag to be taken into
thy hand and carried with thee.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiv.ii-p5">27. Thou shalt not forsake him - Thou shalt give him a
share in such tithes or in the product of them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xiv.ii-p6">28. At the end of three years - That is, in the third
year, as it is, expressed, chap. xxvi, 12. The same year - This is added
to shew that he speaks of the third year, and not of the fourth year, as
some might conjecture from the phrase, at the end of three years.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="50.08%" prev="ii.vi.xiv.ii" next="ii.vi.xv.i" id="ii.vi.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XV" id="ii.vi.xv-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xv-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="50.08%" prev="ii.vi.xv" next="ii.vi.xv.ii" id="ii.vi.xv.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xv.i-p1">Orders concerning the release of debts every seventh
year, ver. 1-6. Concerning lending, ver. 7-11. Concerning the release of
servants, ver. 12-18. Concerning the firstlings, ver. 19-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="50.08%" prev="ii.vi.xv.i" next="ii.vi.xvi" id="ii.vi.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p1">1. At the end - That is, in the last year of the seven,
as is, most evident from ver. 9. And this year of release, as it is,
called below, ver. 9, is the same with the sabbatical year, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiii. 11" id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|23|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.23.11">Exod. xxiii, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p2">2. Every creditor - Here is, a law for poor, insolvent
debtors. Every seventh year was a year of release, when among other acts
of grace, this was one, that every Israelite, who had borrowed money,
and had not been able to pay it before, should this year be released
from it. And tho' if he was able, he was bound in conscience to pay it
afterwards, yet it could not be recovered by law. His brother - This is
added to limit the word neighbour, which is more general, unto a
brother, in nation and religion, an Israelite. The Lord's release - Or,
a release for the Lord, in obedience to his command, for his honour, and
as an acknowledgment of his right in your estates, and of his kindness
in giving and continuing them to you.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p3">4. Save when there shall be no poor - The words may be
rendered thus, as in the margin of our Bibles, To the end that there be
no poor among you. And so they contain a reason of this law, namely,
that none be impoverished and ruined by a rigid exaction of debts.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p4">8. Open thine hand wide - That is, deal bountifully and
liberally with him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p5">9. Beware - Suppress the first risings of such
uncharitableness. It be sin - That is, it be charged upon thee as a
sin.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p6">10. Thine heart shall not be grieved - That is, thou
shalt give, not only with an open hand, but with a willing and chearful
mind, without which thy very charity is uncharitable, and not accepted
by God.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p7">11. The poor shall never cease - God by his providence
will so order it, partly for the punishment of your disobedience, and
partly for the trial and exercise of your obedience to him and charity
to your brother.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p8">12. If thy brother be sold - Either by himself, or his
parents, or as a criminal. Six years - To be computed from the beginning
of his servitude, which is everywhere limited to the space of six
years.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p9">15. The Lord redeemed thee - And brought thee out with
riches, which because they would not, God gave thee as a just recompense
for thy service; and therefore thou shalt follow his example, and send
out thy servant furnished with all convenient provisions.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p10">17. For ever - All the time of his life, or, at least,
'till the year of jubilee. Likewise - That is, either dismiss her with
plenty, or engage her to perpetual servitude, in the same manner and by
the same rites.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p11">19. All the firstling males thou shalt sanctify - Giving
them to God on the eighth day. And thou shalt do no work with the female
firstlings of the cow, nor shear those of the sheep. Even these must be
offered to God as peace-offerings, or used in a religious feast.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xv.ii-p12">20. Year by year - Namely, in the solemn feasts which
returned upon them every year.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="50.13%" prev="ii.vi.xv.ii" next="ii.vi.xvi.i" id="ii.vi.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XVI" id="ii.vi.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xvi-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="50.13%" prev="ii.vi.xvi" next="ii.vi.xvi.ii" id="ii.vi.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.i-p1">A repetition of the laws concerning the passover, ver.
1-8. The feast of pentecost, ver. 9-12 That of tabernacles, ver. 13-15.
All the males are to attend them, ver. 16, 17. An appointment of Judges
and officers, ver. 18-20. A caution against groves and images, ver. 21,
22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="50.14%" prev="ii.vi.xvi.i" next="ii.vi.xvii" id="ii.vi.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p1">1. Observe the month of Abib - Or of new fruits, which
answers to part of March and part of April, and was by a special order
from God made the beginning of their year, in remembrance of their
deliverance out of Egypt. By night - In the night Pharaoh was forced to
give them leave to depart, and accordingly they made preparation for
their departure, and in the morning they perfected the work.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p2">2. The passover - That is, the feast of the passover, and
so the place may be rendered, thou shalt therefore observe the feast of
the passover unto the Lord thy God, with sheep, and with oxen, as is
prescribed, <scripRef passage="Num. xxviii. 18" id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Num|28|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.28.18">Num. xxviii, 18</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p3">3. With it - Or, in it, that is, during the time of the
feast of the passover. Bread of affliction - Bread which is not usual
nor pleasant, to put thee in mind both of thy miseries endured in Egypt;
and of thy hasty coming out of it, which allowed thee no time to leaven
or prepare thy bread.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p4">4. Any of the flesh - That is, of the passover properly
so called.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p5">5. Of thy gates - That is, of thy cities.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p6">6. There - Namely, in the court of the tabernacle or
temple. This he prescribed, partly that this great work might be done
with more solemnity in such manner as God required; partly, because it
was not only a sacrament, but also a sacrifice, and because here was the
sprinkling of blood, which is the essential part of a sacrifice; and
partly to design the place where Christ, the true passover or lamb of
God, was to be slain. At the season - About the time you were preparing
yourselves for it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p7">7. In the morning - The morning after the seventh day.
Thy tents - That is, thy dwellings, which he calls tents, as respecting
their present state, and to put them in mind afterwards when they were
settled in better habitations, that there was a time when they dwelt in
tents.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p8">8. Six days - Namely, besides the first day, on which the
passover was killed.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p9">9. To put the sickle - That is, to reap thy corn, thy
barley, when the first-fruits were offered.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p10">10. Of weeks - Of pentecost. Thou shalt give - Over and
besides what was appointed.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p11">17. Thou shalt rejoice - In God and the effects of his
favour, praising him with a glad heart.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p12">18. Judges - Chief magistrates to examine and determine
causes and differences. Officers - Who were subordinate to the other to
bring causes and persons before him, to acquaint people with the
sentence of the Judges, and to execute their sentence. Thy gates - Thy
cities, which he here calls gates, because there were seats of judgment
set. Pursuant to this law, in every town which contained above an
hundred and twenty families, there was a court of twenty three Judges;
in the smaller towns, a court of three Judges.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p13">19. Wrest judgment - Not give an unjust sentence. A gift
doth blind the eyes - Biasseth his mind, that he cannot discern between
right and wrong. The words - That is the sentence, of those Judges who
are used to do righteous things, it makes them give wrong judgment.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p14">20. That which is altogether just - Hebrew.
righteousness, righteousness, that is, nothing but righteousness in all
causes and times, and to all persons equally.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvi.ii-p15">21. Thou shalt not plant - Because this was the practice
of idolaters, and might be an occasion of reviving idolatry.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="50.19%" prev="ii.vi.xvi.ii" next="ii.vi.xvii.i" id="ii.vi.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XVII" id="ii.vi.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xvii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="50.19%" prev="ii.vi.xvii" next="ii.vi.xvii.ii" id="ii.vi.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.i-p1">A charge, concerning sacrifices, ver. 1. Concerning
putting idolaters to death, ver. 2-7. Concerning the decision of cases
by the sanhedrim, ver. 8-13. Concerning the choice and duty of a king,
ver. 14-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="50.20%" prev="ii.vi.xvii.i" next="ii.vi.xviii" id="ii.vi.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p1">1. Bullock or sheep - Either greater or smaller
sacrifices, all being comprehended under the two most eminent kinds.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p2">2. ln transressing his covenant - That is, in idolatry,
as it is explained ver. 3, which is called a transgression of God's
covenant made with Israel, both because it is a breach of their faith
given to God and of that law which they covenanted to keep; and because
it is a dissolution of that matrimonial covenant with God, a renouncing
of God and his worship, and a chusing other Gods.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p3">3. The host of heaven - Those glorious creatures, which
are to be admired as the wonderful works of God, but not to be set up in
God's stead. By condemning the most specious of all idolaters, he
intimates, how absurd a thing it is to worship stocks and stones, the
works of men's hands. I have not commanded - That is, I have forbidden.
Such negative expressions are emphatical.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p4">6. Witnesses - Namely, credible and competent witnesses.
The Jews rejected the testimonies of children, women, servants, familiar
friends or enemies, persons of dissolute lives or evil fame.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p5">7. First upon him - God thus ordered it, for the caution
of witnesses, that, if they had thro' malice or wrath accused him
falsely, they might now be afraid to imbrue their hands in innocent
blood; and for the security and satisfaction of the people in the
execution of this punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p6">8. For thee - He speaks to the inferior magistrates, who
were erected in several cities. If thou hast not skill to determine,
between blood and blood - That is, in capital causes. Between plea and
plea - In civil causes, about words or estates. Between stroke and
stroke - In criminal causes, concerning blows, or wounds inflicted by
one man upon another. Matters of controversy - That is, such things
being doubtful, and the magistrates divided in their opinions about it.
Chuse - Namely to set up his tabernacle, or temple there; because there
was the abode, both of their sanhedrim, which was constituted of priests
and civil magistrates, and of the high-priests, who were to consult God
by Urim, in matters which could not be decided otherwise.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p7">9. Unto the priests - That is, unto the great council,
which consisted chiefly of the priests and Levites, as being the best
expositors of the laws of God, by which all those controversies were to
be decided. And the high-priest was commonly one of that number,
understood here under the priests, whereof be was the chief. The judge -
Probably the high-priest, to whom it belonged to determine, some at
least, of those controversies, and to expound the law of God. And he may
be distinctly named, tho' he be one of the priests, because of his
eminency, and to shew that amongst the priests, he especially was to be
consulted in such cases. The sentence of judgment - Hebrew. The word, or
matter of judgement, that is, the true state of the cause, and what
judgment or sentence ought to be given in it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p8">10. Thou - Thou shalt pass sentence: he speaks to the
inferior magistrates; who were to give sentence, and came hither to be
advised about it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p9">11. Thou shalt do - In particular suits between man and
man, altho' the judge be hereby confined to his rule in giving the
sentence, yet it seems but fit and reasonable that people should be
bound simply to acquiesce in the sentence of their last and highest
judge, or else there would have been no end of strife.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p10">12. Do presumptuously - That will proudly and obstinately
oppose the sentence given against him. The evil - The evil thing, that
scandal, that pernicious example.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p11">13. When thou shalt - He only foresees and foretells what
they would do, but doth not approve of it. Yea when they did this thing
for this very reason, he declares his utter dislike of it, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. viii. 7" id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|1Sam|8|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.8.7">1 Sam. viii,
7</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p12">15. Thy God shall chuse - Approve of, or appoint. So it
was in Saul and David. God reserved to himself the nomination both of
the family, and of the person. Thy brethren -- of the same nation and
religion; because such a person was most likely to maintain true
religion, and to rule with righteousness, gentleness, and kindness to
his subjects; and that he might be a fit type of Christ their supreme
king, who was to be one of their brethren.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p13">16. He shall not multiply horses - Tho' he might have
horses for his own use, yet he was not to have many horses for his
officers and guard, much less for war, lest he should trust in them. The
multiplying horses is also forbidden, lest it should raise too great a
correspondence with Egypt which furnished Canaan with them. The Lord
hath said - The Lord hath now said to me, and I by his command declare
it to you. Ye shall no more return that way - Into Egypt, lest ye be
again infected with her idolatries.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p14">17. Turn away - From God and his law.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p15">18. He shall write - With his own hand, as the Jews say.
Out of that - Out of the original, which was carefully kept by the
priests in the sanctuary, that it might be a perfect copy, and that it
might have the greater influence upon him, coming to him as from the
hand and presence of God.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p16">19. All the days of his life - 'Tis not enough to have
Bibles, but we must use them, yea, use them daily. Our souls must have
constant meals of that manna, which if well digested, will afford them
true nourishment and strength.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xvii.ii-p17">20. If his heart be not lifted up - He intimates, that
the scriptures diligently read, are a powerful means to keep him humble,
because they shew him in that, tho' a king, he is subject to an higher
monarch, to whom he must give an account of all his administrations, and
receive from him his sentence agreeable to their quality, which is
sufficient to abate the pride of the haughtiest person in the world.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="50.30%" prev="ii.vi.xvii.ii" next="ii.vi.xviii.i" id="ii.vi.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XVIII" id="ii.vi.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xviii-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="50.30%" prev="ii.vi.xviii" next="ii.vi.xviii.ii" id="ii.vi.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.i-p1">Rules concerning priests and Levites, ver. 1-8. Cautions
against witchcraft, ver. 9-14. A promise of Christ, ver. 15-19. The
punishment and mark of a false prophet, ver. 20-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="50.30%" prev="ii.vi.xviii.i" next="ii.vi.xix" id="ii.vi.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p1">1. His inheritance - The Lord's portion or inheritance,
which God had reserved to himself, as tithes and first fruits, and other
oblations distinct from those which were made by fire.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p2">3. The maw - The Hebrew word here rendered maw or
stomach, may have another signification, and some render it the breast,
others take it for the part, which lies under the breast.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p3">6. With all the desire of his mind - With full purpose to
fix his abode, and to spend his whole time and strength in the service
of God. It seems, the several priests were to come from their cities to
the temple by turns, before David's time; and it is certain they did so
after it. But if any of them were not contented with this attendance
upon God in his tabernacle, or temple, and desired more entirely and
constantly to devote himself to God's service there, he was permitted so
to do, because this was an eminent act of piety joined with self -
denial, to part with those great conveniences which he enjoyed in the
city of his possession.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p4">8. Like portions - With their brethren who were in actual
ministration: as they share with them in the work, so shall they in the
encouragements. Beside that which cometh - The reason of this law was,
because he that waited on the altar, ought to live by the altar: and
because it was fit he should keep his money, wherewith he might redeem
what he sold, if afterwards he saw occasion for it. Mr. Henry adds a
remarkable note here: especially considering he wrote threescore years
ago. "A hearty, pious zeal to serve God and his church, tho' it may a
little encroach upon a settled order, and there may be somewhat in it
that looks irregular, yet ought to be gratified, and not discouraged. He
that loves dearly to be employed in the service of the sanctuary: in
God's name let him minster. He shall be as welcome to God as the
Levites, whose course it was to minister, and should be so to them."</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p5">10. Useth divination - Foretelleth things secret or to
come, by unlawful arts and practices. An observer of times -
Superstitiously pronouncing some days lucky, and others unlucky. Or, an
observer of the clouds or heavens, one that divineth by the motions of
the clouds, by the stars, or by the flying or chattering of birds, all
which Heathens used to observe. An inchanter - Or, a conjecturer, that
discovers hidden things by a superstitious use of words or ceremonies,
by observation of water or smoke or any contingencies. A witch - One
that is in covenant with the devil.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p6">11. A charmer - One that charmeth serpents or other
cattle. Or, a fortune-teller, that foretelleth the events of men's lives
by the conjunctions of the stars. Spirits - Whom they call upon by
certain words or rites. A wizard - Hebrew. a knowing man, who by any
forbidden way's undertakes the Revelation of secret things. A
necromancer - One that calleth up and inquireth of the dead.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p7">13. Perfect - Sincerely and wholly his, seeking him and
cleaving to him and to his word alone, and therefore abhorring all
commerce and conversations with devils.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p8">14. Hath not suffered thee so to do - Hath not suffered
thee to follow these superstitious and diabolical practices, as he hath
suffered other nations to do, but hath instructed thee better by his
word and spirit, and will more fully instruct thee by a great
prophet.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p9">15. Will raise up - Will produce and send into the world
in due time. A prophet like unto me - Christ was truly, and in all
commendable parts like him, in being both a prophet and a king and a
priest and mediator, in the excellency of his ministry and work, in the
glory of his miracles, in his familiar and intimate converse with
God.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p10">19. I will require it - I will punish him severely for
it. The sad effect of this threatning the Jews have felt for above
sixteen hundred years together.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xviii.ii-p11">22. If the thing - Which he gives as a sign of the truth
of his prophecy. The falsehood of his prediction shews him to be a false
prophet. Presumptuously - Impudently ascribing his own vain and lying
fancies to the God of truth.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="50.37%" prev="ii.vi.xviii.ii" next="ii.vi.xix.i" id="ii.vi.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XIX" id="ii.vi.xix-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xix-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="50.37%" prev="ii.vi.xix" next="ii.vi.xix.ii" id="ii.vi.xix.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xix.i-p1">Of the cites of refuge, ver. 1-10. Of wilful murderers,
ver. 11-13. Of removing land-marks, ver. 14. Of witnesses, true, ver.
15. Of false, ver. 16-21</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="50.37%" prev="ii.vi.xix.i" next="ii.vi.xx" id="ii.vi.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xix.ii-p1">2. In the midst of the land - Namely, beyond Jordan, as
there were three already appointed on this side Jordan: In the midst of
the several parts of their land, to which they might speedily flee from
all the parts of the land.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xix.ii-p2">3. Prepare thee a way - Distinguish it by evident marks,
and make it plain and convenient, to prevent mistakes and delays.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xix.ii-p3">8. Enlarge thy coast - As far as Euphrates.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xix.ii-p4">9. If thou shalt keep all these commandments - But the
Jewish writers themselves own, that the condition not being performed,
the promise of enlarging their coast was not fulfilled, so that there
was no need for three more cities of refuge. Yet the holy, blessed God,
say they, did not command it in vain, for in the day's of Messiah the
Prince, they shall be added. They expect it in the letter: but we know,
it has in Christ its spiritual accomplishment. For the borders of the
Gospel- Israel are inlarged according to the promise: and in the Lord
our righteousness, refuge is provided for all that by faith fly to
him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xix.ii-p5">15. Rise - Or be established, accepted, owned as
sufficient: it is the same word which in the end of the verse is
rendered, be established.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xix.ii-p6">16. A safe witness - A single witness, though he speak
truth, is not to be accepted for the condemnation of another man, but if
he be convicted of false witness, this is sufficient for his own
condemnation.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xix.ii-p7">21. Eye for eye - What punishment the law allotted to the
accused, if he had been convicted, the same shall the false accuser
bear.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="50.40%" prev="ii.vi.xix.ii" next="ii.vi.xx.i" id="ii.vi.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XX" id="ii.vi.xx-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xx-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="50.40%" prev="ii.vi.xx" next="ii.vi.xx.ii" id="ii.vi.xx.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xx.i-p1">The exhortation of the priest to them who were going to
battle, ver. 1-4. The dismission of them who were engaged in business,
or faint-hearted, ver. 5-9. How they were to treat distant cities, ver.
10-15. The cities of the Canaanites, ver. 16-18. Fruit- trees not to be
destroyed, ver. 19, 20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="50.41%" prev="ii.vi.xx.i" next="ii.vi.xxi" id="ii.vi.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xx.ii-p1">2. Speak unto the people - Probably to one regiment of
the army after another.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xx.ii-p2">5. What man - This and the following exceptions are to be
understood only of a war allowed by God, not in a war commanded by God,
not in the approaching war with the Canaanites, from which even the
bridegroom was not exempted, as the Jewish writers note.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xx.ii-p3">6. A vineyard - This and the former dispensation were
generally convenient, but more necessary in the beginning of their
settlement in Canaan, for the encouragement of those who should build
houses or plant vineyards, which was chargeable to them, and beneficial
to the common-wealth. Eaten of it - Hebrew. made it common, namely, for
the use of himself and family and friends, which it was not, 'till the
fifth year.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xx.ii-p4">9. Make captains - Or rather, as the Hebrew hath it, they
shall set or place the captains of the armies in the head or front of
the people under their charge, that they may conduct them, and by their
example encourage their soldiers. It is not likely they had their
captains to make when they were just going to battle.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xx.ii-p5">16. Nothing - No man. For the beasts, some few excepted,
were given them for a prey.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xx.ii-p6">19. Thou shalt not destroy - Which is to be understood of
a general destruction of them, not of the cutting down some few of them,
as the conveniency of the siege might require. Man's life - The
sustenance or support of his life.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="50.43%" prev="ii.vi.xx.ii" next="ii.vi.xxi.i" id="ii.vi.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXI" id="ii.vi.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxi-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="50.43%" prev="ii.vi.xxi" next="ii.vi.xxi.ii" id="ii.vi.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.i-p1">The expiation of an uncertain murder, ver. 1-9. The usage
of a captive taken to wife, ver. 10-14. The first-born to not to be
disinherited, ver. 15-17. A stubborn son to be put to death, ver. 18-21.
Bodies of malefactors to be buried, ver. 22. 23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="50.44%" prev="ii.vi.xxi.i" next="ii.vi.xxii" id="ii.vi.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p1">1. The field - Or, in the city, or any place: only the
field is named, as the place where such murders are most commonly
committed.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p2">2. Thy elders and Judges - Those of thy elders who are
Judges: the Judges or rulers of all the neighbouring cities. Measure -
Unless it be evident which city is nearest; for then measuring was
superfluous.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p3">3. Which hath not drawn in the yoke - A fit
representative of the murderer, in whose stead it was killed, who would
not bear the yoke of God's laws. A type also of Christ, who was under
the yoke, but what he had voluntarily taken upon himself.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p4">4. A rough valley - That such a desert and horrid place
might beget an horror of murder and of the murderer. Strike off the neck
- To shew what they would and should have done to the murderer if they
had found him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p5">5. Every controversy - Of this kind: every controversy
which shall rise about any stroke, whether such a mortal stroke as is
here spoken of, or any other stroke or wound given by one man to
another.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p6">7. They shall answer - To the priests who shall examine
them. This blood - This about which the present enquiry is made: or this
which is here present: for it is thought the corps of the slain man was
brought into the same place where the heifer was slain. Nor have we seen
or understood how or by whom this was done.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p7">8. Forgiven - Though there was no mortal guilt in this
people, yet there was a ceremonial uncleanness in the land, which was to
be expiated and forgiven.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p8">10. Enemies - Of other nations, but not of the
Canaanites.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p9">11. Hast a desire unto her - Or, hast taken delight in
her: which may be a modest expression for lying with her, and seems
probable, because it is said, ver. 14, that he had humbled her. And here
seem to be two cases supposed, and direction given what to do in both of
them,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p10">1. that he did desire to marry her, of
which he speaks, ver. 11-13.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p11">2. that he did not desire this, of which he
speaks, ver. 14.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p12">12. She shall shave her head - In token of her renouncing
her heathenish idolatry and superstition, and of her becoming a new
woman, and embracing the true religion.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p13">13. Raiment of captivity - Those sordid raiments which
were put upon her when she was taken captive. Bewail her father and
mother - Either their death, or which was in effect the same, her final
separation from them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p14">14. If thou have no delight in her - If thou dost not
chuse to marry her. Thou shalt not make merchandise of her - Make gain
of her, either by using her to thy own servile works, or by prostituting
her to the lusts or to the service of others.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p15">15. Two wives - This practice, though tolerated, is not
hereby made lawful; but only provision is made for the children in this
case. Hated - Comparatively, that is, less loved.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p16">19. His father and mother - The consent of both is
required to prevent the abuse of this law to cruelty. And it cannot
reasonably be supposed that both would agree without the son's
abominable and incorrigible wickedness, in which case it seems a
righteous law, because the crime of rebellion against his own parents
did so fully signify what a pernicious member he would be in the
commonwealth of Israel, who had dissolved all his natural obligations.
Unto the elders - Which was a sufficient caution to preserve children
from the malice of any hard-hearted parents, because these elders were
first to examine the cause with all exactness, and then to pronounce the
sentence.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p17">20. A glutton and a drunkard - Under which two offenses
others of a like or worse nature are comprehended.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p18">22. On a tree - Which was done after the malefactor was
put to death some other way, this publick shame being added to his
former punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p19">23. He is accursed of God - He is in a singular manner
cursed and punished by God's appointment with a most shameful kind of
punishment, as this was held among the Jews and all nations; and
therefore this punishment may suffice for him, and there shall not be
added to it that of lying unburied. And this curse is here appropriated
to those that are hanged, to so signify that Christ should undergo this
execrable punishment, and be made a curse for us, <scripRef passage="Gal. iii. 13" id="ii.vi.xxi.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Gal|3|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.3.13">Gal. iii, 13</scripRef>, which though it was to come in respect to men, yet was
present unto God. Defiled - Either by inhumanity towards the dead: or by
suffering the monument of the man's wickedness, and of God's curse, to
remain publick a longer time than God would have it, whereas it should
be put out of sight, and buried in oblivion.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="50.51%" prev="ii.vi.xxi.ii" next="ii.vi.xxii.i" id="ii.vi.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXII" id="ii.vi.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="50.51%" prev="ii.vi.xxii" next="ii.vi.xxii.ii" id="ii.vi.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.i-p1">Laws for preserving stray or fallen cattle, ver. 1-4. For
a distinction of apparel between women and men, ver. 5. For compassion
even toward birds, ver. 6, 7. Of battlements on houses, ver. 8. Against
improper mixtures, ver. 9-11. Of fringes, ver. 12. Of a wife, falsely
accused, ver. 13-19. Justly accused, ver. 20, 21. The punishment of
adultery, rape, fornication, ver. 22-29. Of incest, ver. 30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXII" progress="50.52%" prev="ii.vi.xxii.i" next="ii.vi.xxiii" id="ii.vi.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p1">1. Thy brother's - Any man's. Thou shalt not hide thyself
- Dissemble or pretend that thou dost not see them; or pass them by as
if thou hadst not seen them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p2">2. To thine own house - To be used like thine own
cattle.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p3">3. Hide thyself - Dissemble that thou hast found it. Or,
hide it, that is, conceal the thing lost.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p4">5. Shall not wear - Namely, ordinarily or unnecessarily,
for in some cases this may be lawful, as to make an escape for one's
life. Now this is forbidden, both for decency sake, that men might not
confound those sexes which God hath distinguished, that all appearance
of evil might be avoided, such change of garments carrying a manifest
sign of effeminacy in the man, of arrogance in the woman, of lightness
and petulancy in both; and also to cut off all suspicions and occasions
of evil, which this practice opens a wide door to.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p5">7. Let the dam go - Partly for the bird's sake, which
suffered enough by the loss of its young; for God would not have cruelty
exercised towards the brute creatures: and partly for mens sake, to
refrain their greediness, that, they should not monopolize all to
themselves, but leave the hopes of a future seed for others.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p6">8. A battlement - A fence or breastwork, because the
roofs of their houses were made flat, that men might walk on them. Blood
- The guilt of blood, by a man's fall from the top of thy house, thro'
thy neglect of this necessary provision. The Jew's say, that by the
equity of this law, they are obliged, and so are we, to fence or remove
every thing, whereby life may he endangered, as wells, or bridges, lest
if any perish thro' our omission, their blood be required at our
hand.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p7">9. Divers seeds - Either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p8">1. With divers kinds of seed mixed and
sowed together between the rows of vines in thy vineyard: which was
forbidden to be done in the field, <scripRef passage="Lev. xix. 19" id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Lev|19|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.19">Lev. xix, 19</scripRef>, and here, in the vineyard. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p9">2. With any kind of seed differing from
that of the vine, which would produce either herbs, or corn, or
fruit-bearing trees, whose fruit might be mingled with the fruit of the
vines. Now this and the following precepts, tho' in themselves small and
trivial, are given, according to that time and state of the church, for
instructions in greater matters, and particularly to commend to them
simplicity in all their carriage towards God and man, and to forbid all
mixture of their inventions with God's institutions in doctrine or
worship. Defiled - Legally and morally, as being prohibited by God's
law, and therefore made unclean; as on the contrary, things are
sanctified by God's word, allowing and approving them, <scripRef passage="1 Tim. iv. 5" id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|1Tim|4|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Tim.4.5">1 Tim. iv, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p10">10. An ox and an ass - Because the one was a clean beast,
the other unclean whereby God would teach men to avoid polluting
themselves by the touch of unclean persons or things.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p11">12. Fringes - Or laces, or strings, partly to bring the
commands of God to their remembrance, as it is expressed, <scripRef passage="Num. xv. 38" id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Num|15|38|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.15.38">Num. xv, 38</scripRef>, and partly is a public profession of their nation and
religion, whereby they might be distinguished from strangers, that so
they might be more circumspect to behave as became the people of God,
and that they should own their religion before all the world. Thou
coverest thyself - These words seem restrictive to the upper garment
wherewith the rest were covered.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p12">13. If any man take a wife - And afterward falsely accuse
her- What the meaning of that evidence is, by which the accusation was
proved false, the learned are not agreed. Nor is it necessary for us to
know: they for whom this law was intended, undoubtedly understood
it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p13">19. The father - Because this was a reproach to his
family, and to himself, as such a miscarriage of his daughter would have
been ascribed to his evil education.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p14">24. She cried not - And therefore is justly presumed to
have consented to it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p15">26. Even so - Not an act of choice, but of force and
constraint.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p16">27. The damsel cried - Which is in that case to be
presumed; charity obliging us to believe the best, 'till the contrary be
manifest.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p17">29. Fifty shekels - Besides the dowry, as Philo, the
learned Jew notes, which is here omitted, because that was customary, it
being sufficient here to mention what was peculiar to this case. His
wife - If her father consented to it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxii.ii-p18">30. Take - To wife. So this respects the state, and the
next branch speaks of the act only.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="50.60%" prev="ii.vi.xxii.ii" next="ii.vi.xxiii.i" id="ii.vi.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXIII" id="ii.vi.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxiii-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="50.60%" prev="ii.vi.xxiii" next="ii.vi.xxiii.ii" id="ii.vi.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.i-p1">Who are to be excluded the congregation of rulers, ver.
1-6. An Edomite and an Egyptian not to be abhorred, ver. 7, 8. No
uncleanness to be in the camp, ver. 9-14. Of servants, escaped from
their masters, ver. 15, 16. Laws, against sodomy and whoredom, ver. 17,
18. Against usury, ver. 19, 20. Against the breach of vows, ver. 21-23.
The liberty which might be taken in another's field or vineyard, ver.
24, 25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="50.60%" prev="ii.vi.xxiii.i" next="ii.vi.xxiv" id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p1">1. He that is wounded - A phrase denoting an eunuch.
Shall not enter into the congregation of the Lord - Shall not be
admitted to honours and offices either in the church or commonwealth of
Israel; and so the congregation of the Lord doth not here signify, the
body of the people, but the society of the elders or rulers of the
people. Add to this, that the Hebrew word, Kahal, generally signifies a
congregation or company of men met together; and therefore this cannot
so conveniently be meant of all the body of the people, which could
never meet in one place, but of the chief rulers, which frequently did
so. Nor is it strange that eunuchs are excluded from government, both
because such persons are commonly observed to want that courage which is
necessary for a governor, because as such persons ordinarily were
despicable, so the authority in their hands was likely to be exposed to
the same contempt.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p2">2. The congregation - Taking the word as in the former
verse.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p3">3. For ever - This seems to note the perpetuity of this
law, that it should be inviolably observed in all succeeding ages.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p4">4. They met you not with bread and water - As the manner
of those times was to wait and provide for strangers and travelers,
which was the more necessary, because in those times and countries,
there were no public houses of entertainment. Their fault then was
unmercifulness to strangers and afflicted persons, which was aggravated
both by their relation to the Israelites, as being the children of Lot,
and by the special kindness of God, and of the Israelites to them, in
not fighting against them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p5">6. Thou shalt not seek their peace - That is, make no
contracts either by marriages or leagues, or commerce with them, but
rather constantly keep a jealous eye over them, as enemies who will
watch every opportunity to ensnare or disturb thee. This counsel was now
the more necessary, because a great part of the Israelites lived beyond
Jordan in the borders of those people, and therefore God sets up this
wall of partition betwixt them, as well knowing the mischief of bad
neighbours, and Israel's proneness to receive infection from them. Each
particular Israelite is not hereby forbidden to perform any office of
humanity to them, but the body of the nation are forbidden all familiar
conversation with them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p6">7. Thou wast a stranger - And didst receive habitation,
protection and provision from them a long time, which kindness thou must
not forget for their following persecution. It is ordinary with men,
that one injury blots out the remembrance of twenty courtesies; but God
doth not deal so with us, nor will he have us to deal so with others,
but commands us to forget injuries, and to remember kindnesses.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p7">8. In their third generation - Supposing their
grandfather, or great- grandfather turned proselyte, and the children
continue in that faith received by such ancestors.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p8">9. Keep from every wicked thing - Then especially take
heed, because that is a time of confusion and licentiousness; when the
laws of God and man cannot be heard for the noise of arms; because the
success of thy arms depends upon God's blessing, which wicked men have
no reason to expect; and because thou dost carry thy life in thy hand,
and therefore hast need to be well prepared for death and judgment.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p9">13. Cover - To prevent the annoyance of ourselves or
others; to preserve and exercise modesty and natural honesty; and
principally that by such outward rites they might be innured to the
greater reverence of the Divine Majesty, and the greater caution to
avoid all real and moral uncleanness.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p10">15. The servant - Of such as belonged to the Canaanites,
or other neighbouring nations, because if he had lived in remote
countries, it is not probable that he would flee so far to avoid his
master, or that his master would follow him so far to recover him. For
the Canaanites this sentence was most just, because both they and theirs
were all forfeited to God and Israel, and whatsoever they enjoyed was by
special indulgence. And for the other neighbours it may seem just also,
because both masters and servants of these and other nations are
unquestionably at the disposal of the Lord their maker and sovereign
ruler. Understand it likewise of such as upon enquiry appear to have
been unjustly oppressed by their masters. Now it is not strange if the
great God, who hates all tyranny, and styles himself the refuge of the
oppressed doth interpose his authority to rescue such persons from their
cruel masters.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p11">17. No whore - No common prostitute, such as were
tolerated and encouraged by the Gentiles, and used even in their
religious worship. Not that such practices were allowed to the strangers
among them, as is evident from many scriptures and reasons, but that it
was in a peculiar manner, and upon special reasons, forbidden to them,
as being much more odious in them than in strangers.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p12">18. The hire of a whore - This is opposed to the practice
of the Gentiles, who allowed both such persons and the oblations they
made out of their infamous gains; and some of them kept lewd women, who
prostituted themselves in the temples, to the honour of their false
Gods, and offered part of their profit to them. Or the price of a dog -
It seems to mean, of a whoremonger or sodomite. Such are called dogs, <scripRef passage="Rev. xxii. 15" id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Rev|22|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.22.15">Rev. xxii, 15</scripRef>. And it is not improbable they are called so here. From
these God would not accept of any offering.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p13">19. Thou shalt not lend upon usury to thy brother - To an
Israelite. They held their estates immediately from God, who while he
distinguished them from all other people, might have ordered, had he
pleased, that they should have all things in common. But instead of
that, and in token of their joint interest in the good land he had given
them, he only appointed them, as there was occasion, to lend to one
another without interest. This among them would be little or no loss to
the lender, because their land was so divided, their estates so settled,
and there was so little a merchandise among them, that it was seldom or
never they had occasion to borrow any great sums, but only for the
subsistence of their family, or some uncommon emergence. But they might
lend to a stranger upon usury, who was supposed to live by trade, and
therefore got by what he borrowed: in which case 'tis just, the lender
should share in the gain. This usury therefore is not oppressive: for
they might not oppress a stranger.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p14">21. Not slack - Not delay: because delays may make them
both unable to pay it, and unwilling too.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p15">23. A free-will-offering - Which though thou didst really
make, yet being made, thou art no longer free, but obliged to perform
it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiii.ii-p16">24. At thy pleasure - Which was allowed in those parts,
because of the great plenty and fruitfulness of vines there.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="50.72%" prev="ii.vi.xxiii.ii" next="ii.vi.xxiv.i" id="ii.vi.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXIV" id="ii.vi.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxiv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIV" progress="50.72%" prev="ii.vi.xxiv" next="ii.vi.xxiv.ii" id="ii.vi.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.i-p1">Of Divorce, ver. 1-4. New-married men discharged from the
war, ver. 5. Of pledges, ver. 6. 10-13. Of man-stealers, ver. 7. Of the
leprosy, ver. 8, 9. Of daily wages, ver. 14, 15. None to be punished for
another's sin, ver. 16. Of justice and mercy to the widow, fatherless
and stranger, ver. 17-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIV" progress="50.73%" prev="ii.vi.xxiv.i" next="ii.vi.xxv" id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p1">1. Some uncleanness - Some hateful thing, some distemper
of body or quality of mind not observed before marriage: or some light
carriage, as this phrase commonly signifies, but not amounting to
adultery. Let him write - This is not a command as some of the Jews
understood it, nor an allowance and approbation, but merely a permission
of that practice for prevention of greater mischiefs, and this only
until the time of reformation, till the coming of the Messiah when
things were to return to their first institution and purest
condition.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p2">4. May not - This is the punishment of his levity and
injustice in putting her away without sufficient cause, which by this
offer he now acknowledgeth. Defiled - Not absolutely, as if her second
marriage were a sin, but with respect to her first husband, to whom she
is as a defiled or unclean woman, that is, forbidden things; forbidden
are accounted and called unclean, <scripRef passage="Judg. xiii. 7" id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Judg|13|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.13.7">Judg. xiii, 7</scripRef>, because they may no more be touched or used than an unclean
thing. Thou shalt not cause the land to sin - Thou shalt not suffer such
lightness to be practiced, lest the people be polluted, and the land
defiled and accursed by that means.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p3">5. Business - Any publick office or employment, which may
cause an absence from or neglect of his wife. One year - That their
affections may be firmly settled, so as there may be no occasions for
the divorces last mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p4">6. Mill-stone - Used in their hand-mills. Under this, he
understands all other things necessary to get a livelihood, the taking
away whereof is against the laws both of charity and prudence, seeing by
those things alone he can be enabled both to subsist and to pay his
debts. Life - His livelihood, the necessary support of his life.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p5">10. Thou shalt not go in - To prevent both the poor man's
reproach by having his wants exposed, and the creditor's greediness
which might be occasioned by the sight of something which he desired,
and the debtor could not spare.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p6">11. The pledge - He shall chuse what pledge he pleases,
provided it be sufficient for the purpose.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p7">12. Thou shalt not sleep - But restore it before night,
which intimates that he should take no such thing for pledge, without
which a man cannot sleep.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p8">13. Bless thee - Bring down the blessing of God upon thee
by his prayers: for though his prayers, if he be not a good man, shall
not avail for his own behalf, yet they shall avail for thy benefit. It
shall be right - Esteemed and accepted by God as a work of
righteousness, or mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p9">15. At this day - At the time appointed, weekly or
daily.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p10">16. Not put to death - If the one be free from the guilt
of the others sin, except in those cases where the sovereign Lord of
life and death, before whom none is innocent, hath commanded it, as
chap. xiii, 1-18 <scripRef passage="Josh. vii. 24" id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Josh|7|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.7.24">Josh. vii, 24</scripRef>. For though God do visit the father's sins upon the
children, <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 5" id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p10.2" parsed="|Exod|20|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.5">Exod. xx, 5</scripRef>, yet he will not suffer men to do so.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxiv.ii-p11">17. Raiment - Not such as she hath daily and necessary
use of, as being poor. But this concerns not rich persons, nor
superfluous raiment.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="50.78%" prev="ii.vi.xxiv.ii" next="ii.vi.xxv.i" id="ii.vi.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXV" id="ii.vi.xxv-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxv-p0.2">XXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXV" progress="50.78%" prev="ii.vi.xxv" next="ii.vi.xxv.ii" id="ii.vi.xxv.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.i-p1">Stripes not to exceed forty, ver. 1-3. The ox not to be
muzzled, ver. 4. Of marrying the brother's widow, ver. 5-10. Of an
immodest woman, ver. 11, 12. Of just weights and measures, ver. 13-16.
Amalek to be destroyed, ver. 17-19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXV" progress="50.79%" prev="ii.vi.xxv.i" next="ii.vi.xxvi" id="ii.vi.xxv.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p1">1. Justify - Acquit him from guilt and false accusations,
and free him from punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p2">2. Beaten - Which the Jews say was the case of all those
crimes which the law commands to be punished, without expressing the
kind or degree of punishment. Before his face - That the punishment may
be duly inflicted, without excess or defect. And from this no person's
rank or quality exempted him, if he was a delinquent.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p3">3. Forty stripes - It seems not superstition, but prudent
caution, when the Jews would not exceed thirty-nine stripes, lest
through mistake or forgetfulness they should go beyond their bounds,
which they were commanded to keep. Should seem vile - Should be made
contemptible to his brethren, either by this cruel usage of him, as if
he were a brute beast: or by the deformity or infirmity of body which
excessive beating might produce.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p4">4. He treadeth out the corn - Which they did in those
parts, either immediately by their hoofs on by drawing carts or other
instruments over the corn. Hereby God taught them humanity, even to
their beasts that served them, and much more to their servants or other
men who laboured for them, especially to their ministers, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. ix. 9" id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Cor|9|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.9.9">1 Cor. ix, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p5">5. Together - In the same town, or at least country. For
if the next brother had removed his habitation into remote parts, on
were carried thither into captivity, then the wife of the dead had her
liberty to marry the next kinsman that lived in the same place with her.
One - Any of them, for the words are general, and the reason of the law
was to keep up the distinction of tribes and families, that so the
Messiah might be discovered by the family from which he was appointed to
proceed; and also of inheritances, which were divided among all the
brethren, the first-born having only a double portion. A stranger - To
one of another family.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p6">6. That his name be not put out - That a family be not
lost. So this was a provision that the number of their families might
not be diminished.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p7">9. Loose his shoe - As a sign of his resignation of all
his right to the woman, and to her husband's inheritance: for as the
shoe was a sign of one's power and right, <scripRef passage="Psalm lx. 8" id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Ps|60|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.60.8">Psalm lx, 8</scripRef>; cviii, 9, so the parting with the shoe was a token of the
alienation of such right; and as a note of infamy, to signify that by
this disingenuous action he was unworthy to be amongst free-men, and fit
to be reduced to the condition of the meanest servants, who used to go
barefoot, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xx. 2, 4" id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Isa|20|2|0|0;|Isa|20|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.20.2 Bible:Isa.20.4">Isaiah
xx, 2, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p8">10. His name - That is, his person, and his posterity
also. So it was a lasting blot.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p9">13. A great and a small - The great to buy with, the
small for selling.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxv.ii-p10">17. Out of Egypt - Which circumstance greatly aggravates
their sin, that they should do thus to a people, who had been long
exercised with sore afflictions, to whom pity was due by the laws of
nature and humanity, and for whose rescue God had in so glorious a
manner appeared, which they could not be ignorant of. So this was
barbarousness to Israel, and setting the great Jehovah at defiance.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="50.84%" prev="ii.vi.xxv.ii" next="ii.vi.xxvi.i" id="ii.vi.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXVI" id="ii.vi.xxvi-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.26" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxvi-p0.2">XXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVI" progress="50.84%" prev="ii.vi.xxvi" next="ii.vi.xxvi.ii" id="ii.vi.xxvi.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.i-p1">A form of confession made by him that offered the first-
fruits, ver. 1-11. A prayer to be made after the disposal of the third
year's tithe, ver. 12-15. He binds all these precepts upon them, by the
divine authority, and the covenant between God and them, ver. 16-19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVI" progress="50.85%" prev="ii.vi.xxvi.i" next="ii.vi.xxvii" id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p1">2. Thou shalt take - This seems to be required of each
master of a family, either upon his first settlement, or once every year
at one of their three feasts, when they were obliged to go up to
Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p2">5. A Syrian - So Jacob was, partly by his original, as
being born of Syrian parents, as were Abraham and Rebecca, both of
Chaldea or Mesopotamia, which was a part of Syria largely so called,
partly by his education and conversation; and partly by his relations,
his wives being such, and his children too by their mother's. Ready to
perish - Either through want and poverty; (See <scripRef passage="Gen. xxviii. 11, 20" id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Gen|28|11|0|0;|Gen|28|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.28.11 Bible:Gen.28.20">Gen. xxviii, 11, 20</scripRef>; xxxii, 10,) or through the rage of his brother Esau, and
the treachery of his father-in-law Laban.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p3">10. It - The basket of first-fruits, ver. 2.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p4">11. Thou shalt rejoice - Thou shalt hereby enabled to
take comfort in all thy employments, when thou hast sanctified them by
giving God his portion. It is the will of God, that we should be
chearful not only in our attendance upon his holy ordinances, but in our
enjoyment of the gifts of his providence. Whatever good thing God gives
us, we should make the most comfortable use of it we can, still tracing
the streams to the fountain of all consolation.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p5">12. The year of tithing - Hebrew. the year of that tithe,
so called, either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p6">1. because these tithes were gathered only
in that year. Or rather,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p7">2. because then only they were so bestowed;
and whereas these second tithes for two years together were eaten only
by the owners and Levites, and that in Jerusalem, in the third year they
were eaten also by the strangers, fatherless, and widows, and that in
their own dwellings.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p8">13. Before the Lord - In thy private addresses to God;
for this is to be said presently upon the distribution of these tithes,
which was not done at Jerusalem, but in their own private gates or
dwellings. And this is to be spoken before the Lord, that is, solemnly,
seriously, and in a religious manner, with due respect to God's
presence, and will, and glory.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p9">14. In my mourning - In sorrow, or grieving that I was to
give away so much of my profits to the poor, but I have cheerfully eaten
and feasted with them, as I was obliged to do. Unclean use - For any
common use; for any other use than that which thou hast appointed, which
would have been a pollution of them. For the dead - For any funeral pomp
or service; for the Jews used to send in provisions to feast with the
nearest relations of the party deceased; and in that case both the
guests and food were legally polluted, <scripRef passage="Num. xix. 11, 14" id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Num|19|11|0|0;|Num|19|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.19.11 Bible:Num.19.14">Num. xix, 11, 14</scripRef>, and therefore the use of these tithes in such cases had
been a double fault, both the defiling of sacred food, and the employing
those provisions upon sorrowful occasions, which by God's express
command were to be eaten with rejoicing.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p10">15. Look down - After that solemn profession of their
obedience to God's commands, they are taught to pray for God's blessing
whereby they are instructed how vain and ineffectual the prayers of
unrighteous or disobedient persons are.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p11">17. Avouched - Or, declared, or owned.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvi.ii-p12">18. Avouched thee - Hath owned thee for such before all
the world by eminent and glorious manifestations of his power and
favour, by a solemn entering into covenant with thee, and giving
peculiar laws, promises, and privileges to thee above all mankind.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="50.90%" prev="ii.vi.xxvi.ii" next="ii.vi.xxvii.i" id="ii.vi.xxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXVII" id="ii.vi.xxvii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.27" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxvii-p0.2">XXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVII" progress="50.90%" prev="ii.vi.xxvii" next="ii.vi.xxvii.ii" id="ii.vi.xxvii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.i-p1">A command to write all the law upon stones, ver. 1-8. A
charge to Israel, to obey God, ver. 9-10. To pronounce a blessing on
mount Gerizzim, and a curse on mount Ebal, ver. 11-13. To the Levites,
to pronounce the whole curse, ver. 14-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVII" progress="50.91%" prev="ii.vi.xxvii.i" next="ii.vi.xxviii" id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p1">2. On that day - About that time, for it was not done
'till some days after their passing over. 3. This law - The law properly
so called, that is, the sum and substance of the precepts or laws of
Moses, especially such as were moral, particularly the decalogue. Write
it, that thou mayest go in - As the condition of thy entering into the
land. For since Canaan is given only by promise, it must be held by
obedience.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p2">4. Mount Ebal - The mount of cursing. Here the law is
written, to signify that a curse was due to the violators of it, and
that no man could expect justification from the works of the law, by the
sentence whereof all men are justly accused, as being all guilty of the
transgression of it in one kind and degree or other. Here the sacrifices
are to be offered, to shew that there is no way to be delivered from
this curse, but by the blood of Christ, which all these sacrifices did
typify, and by Christ's being made a curse for us.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p3">6. Whole stones - Rough, not hewed or polished. By the
law written on the stones, God spake to them: by the altar and
sacrifices upon it, they spake to God: and thus was communion kept up
between them and God.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p4">9. The people of the Lord - By thy solemn renewing of thy
covenant with him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p5">12. Upon mount Gerizzim - These words may be rendered
beside or near to mount Gerizzim. There were in Canaan two mountains
that lay near together, with a valley between, one called Gerizzim, the
other Ebal. On the sides of these which faced each other, all the tribes
were to be drawn up, six on a side, so that in the valley they came near
each other, so near that the priests standing between them, might be
heard by them that were next them on both sides. Then one of the
priests, or perhaps more, at some distance from each other, pronounced
with a loud voice, one of the curses following. And all the people who
stood on the foot and side of mount Ebal, (those farther off taking the
signal from those who were nearer) said Amen! Then the contrary blessing
was pronounced, "Blessed is he that doth so or so:" To which all who
stood on the foot and side of mount Gerizzim, said, Amen! Simeon - All
these were the children of the free-women, Leah and Rachel, to shew both
the dignity of the blessings above the curses, and that the blessings
belong only to those who are evangelically such, as this is expounded
and applied, <scripRef passage="Gal. iv. 22" id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Gal|4|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.4.22">Gal. iv, 22</scripRef>, even to those that receive the Spirit of adoption and
liberty. Joseph is here put for both his sons and tribes Manasseh and
Ephraim, which are reckoned as one tribe, because Levi is here numbered;
but when Levi is omitted, as it is where the division of the land is
made, there Manasseh and Ephraim pass for two tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p6">13. To curse - Of the former tribes, 'tis said, they
stood to bless the people: of these, that they stood to curse. Perhaps
the different way of speaking intimates, That Israel in general were an
happy people, and should ever be so, if they were obedient. And to that
blessing, they on mount Gerizzim said, Amen! But the curses come in,
only as exceptions to the general rule: "Israel is a blessed people: but
if there be any even among them, that do such and such things, they have
no part or lot in this matter, but are under a curse." This shews how
ready God is to bestow the blessing: if any fall under the curse, they
bring it on their own head. Four of these are children of the
bond-woman, to shew that the curse belongs to those of servile and
disingenuous spirits. With these are joined Reuben, who by his shameful
sin fell from his dignity, and Zebulun, the youngest of Leah's children,
that the numbers might be equal.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p7">14. The Levites - Some of the Levites, namely, the
priests, who bare the ark, as it is expressed <scripRef passage="Josh. viii. 33" id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Josh|8|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.8.33">Josh. viii, 33</scripRef>, for the body of the Levites stood upon mount Gerizzim, ver.
12. But these stood in the valley between Gerizzim and Ebal, looking
towards the one or the other mountain as they pronounced either the
blessings or the curses.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p8">15. Cursed - The curses are expressed, but not the
blessings. For as many as were under the law, were under the curse. But
it was an honour reserved for Christ to bless us; to do that which the
law could not do. So in his sermon on the mount, the true mount
Gerizzim, we have blessings only. The man - Under this particular he
understands all the gross violations of the first table, as under the
following branches he comprehends all other sins against the second
table. Amen - 'Tis easy to understand the meaning of Amen to the
blessings. But how could they say it to the curses? It was both a
profession of their faith in the truth of it, and an acknowledgment of
the equity of these curses. So that when they said Amen, they did in
effect Say, not only, it is certain it shall be so, but it is just it
should be so.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p9">16. Light - Or, despiseth in his heart: or reproacheth or
curseth, secretly: for if the fact was notorious, it was punished with
death.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p10">17. Out of the way - That misleadeth simple souls, giving
them pernicious counsel, either for this life, or for the next.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p11">24. Smiteth - That is, killeth. This includes murder
under colour of law, which is of all others the greatest affront to God.
Cursed therefore is he that any ways contributes to accuse, or convict,
or condemn an innocent person.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxvii.ii-p12">26. Confirmeth not - Or, performeth not. To this we must
all say, Amen! Owning ourselves to be under the curse, and that we must
have perished forever, if Christ had not redeemed us from the curse of
the law, by being made a curse for us.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVIII" progress="51.01%" prev="ii.vi.xxvii.ii" next="ii.vi.xxviii.i" id="ii.vi.xxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXVIII" id="ii.vi.xxviii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|28|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.28" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxviii-p0.2">XXVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVIII" progress="51.01%" prev="ii.vi.xxviii" next="ii.vi.xxviii.ii" id="ii.vi.xxviii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.i-p1">The blessings of obedience, personal, family and
national, ver. 1-14. The curses of the disobedient; their extreme
vexation, ver. 15-44. Their utter ruin and destruction, ver. 45-68.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVIII" progress="51.01%" prev="ii.vi.xxviii.i" next="ii.vi.xxix" id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p1">2. Overtake thee - Those blessings which others greedily
follow after, and never overtake, shall follow after thee, and shall be
thrown into thy lap by special kindness.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p2">3. In the city, and in the field - Whether they were
husbandmen or tradesmen, whether in the town or country, they should be
preserved from the dangers of both, and have the comforts of both. How
constantly must we depend upon God, both for the continuance and comfort
of life! We need him at every turn: we cannot be safe, if he withdraw
his protection, nor easy, if he suspends his savour: but if he bless us,
go where we will, 'tis well with us.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p3">5. Store - Store-house, it shall always be well
replenished and the provision thou hast there shall be preserved for thy
use and service.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p4">6. Comest in - That is, in all thy affairs and
administrations.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p5">9. Establish thee - Shall confirm his covenant with thee,
by which he separated thee to himself as an holy and peculiar
people.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p6">10. Of the Lord - That you are in truth his people and
children: A most excellent and glorious people, under the peculiar care
and countenance of the great God.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p7">11. The same things which were said before are repeated,
to shew that God would repeat and multiply his blessings upon them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p8">12. His treasure - The heaven or the air, which is God's
storehouse, where he treasures up rain or wind for man's use.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p9">13. The head - The chief of all people in power, or at
least in dignity and privileges; so that even they that are not under
thine authority shall reverence thy greatness and excellency. So it was
in David's and Solomon's time, and so it should have been much oftner
and much more, if they had performed the conditions.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p10">15. Overtake thee - So that thou shalt not be able to
escape them, as thou shalt vainly hope and endeavour to do. There is no
running from God, but by running to him; no flying from his justice, but
by flying to his mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p11">20. Vexation - This seems chiefly to concern the mind,
arising from the disappointment of hopes and the presages of its
approaching miseries. Rebuke - Namely, from God, not so much in words as
by his actions, by cross providences, by sharp and sore afflictions.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p12">23. Brass - Like brass, hard and dry, and shut up from
giving rain. Iron - Hard and chapt and barren.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p13">24. Dust - Either thy rain shall be as unprofitable to
thy ground and seed as if it were only so much dust. Or instead of rain
shall come nothing but dust from heaven, which being raised and carried
up by the wind in great abundance, returns, and falls upon the earth as
it were in clouds or showers.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p14">27. The botch of Egypt - Such boils and blains as the
Egyptians were plagued with, spreading from head to foot: The emerodes -
Or piles.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p15">28. Blindness - Of mind, so that they shall not know what
to do: Astonishment - They shall be filled with wonder and horror
because of the strangeness and soreness of their calamities.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p16">29. Grope at noon day - In the most clear and evident
matters thou shalt grossly mistake. Thy ways - Thy counsels and
enterprizes shall be frustrated and turn to thy destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p17">32. Unto another people - By those who have conquered
them, and taken them captives, who shall give or sell them to other
persons. Fail - Or, be consumed, partly with grief and plentiful tears;
and partly with earnest desire, and vain and long expectation of their
return. No might - No power to rescue, nor money to ransom them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p18">33. Which thou knowest not - Which shall come from a far
country, which thou didst not at all expect or fear, and therefore will
be the more dreadful when they come; a nation whose language thou
understandest not, and therefore canst not plead with them for mercy,
nor expect any favour from them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p19">34. Thou shalt be mad for the sight of thine eyes - Quite
put out of the possession of their own souls; quite bereaved of all
comfort and hope, and abandoned to utter despair. They that walk by
sight, and not by faith, are in danger of losing reason itself, when all
about them looks frightful; and their condition is bad indeed, who are
mad for the sight of their eyes.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p20">36. Thy king - The calamity shall be both universal,
which even thy king shall not be able to avoid, much less the subjects,
who have far less advantage and opportunity for escape; and
irrecoverable, because he who should protect or rescue them is lost with
them, <scripRef passage="Lam. iv. 10" id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p20.1" parsed="|Lam|4|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lam.4.10">Lam. iv, 10</scripRef>. Wood and stone - So what formerly was their choice and
delight now becomes their plague and misery. And this doubtless was the
condition of many Israelites under the Assyrian and Balylonish
captivities.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p21">43. Within thee - Within thy gates; who formerly honoured
and served thee, and were some of them glad of the crumbs which fell
from thy table.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p22">45. Moreover all these curses - It seems Moses has been
hitherto foretelling their captivity in Babylon, by which even after
their return, they were brought to the low condition mentioned, ver. 44.
But in the following he foretells their last destruction by the Romans.
And the present deplorable state of the Jewish nation, so exactly
answers this prediction, that it is an incontestable proof of the truth
of the prophecy, and consequently of the divine authority of the
scriptures. And this destruction more dreadful than the former shews,
that their sin in rejecting Christ, was more provoking to God than
idolatry itself, and left them more under the power of Satan. For their
captivity in Babylon cured them effectually of idolatry in seventy
years. But under this last destruction, they continue above sixteen
hundred years incurably averse to the Lord Jesus.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p23">46. They - These curses now mentioned. A wonder - Signal
and wonderful to all that hear of them. 'Tis amazing, a people so
incorporated, should be so universally disperst! And that a people
scattered in all nations, should not mix with any, but like Cain, be
fugitives and vagabonds, and yet so marked as to be known.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p24">54. Evil - Unkind, envious, covetous to monopolize these
dainty bits to themselves, and grudging that their dearest relations
should have any part of them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p25">56. Evil - Unmerciful: she will desire or design their
destruction for her food.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p26">57. Her young one - Hebrew. after-birth: that which was
loathsome to behold, will now be pleasant to eat; and together with it
she shall eat the child which was wrapt up in it, and may be included in
this expression. Which she shall bear - Or, which she shall have born,
that is, her more grown children. She shall eat them - This was
fulfilled more than once, to the perpetual reproach of the Jewish
nation. Never was the like done either by Greek or Barbarian. See the
fruit of being abandoned by God!</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p27">63. To destroy you - His just indignation against you
will be so great, that it will be a pleasure to him to take vengeance on
you. For though he doth not delight in the death of a sinner in itself,
yet he doth delight in glorifying his justice upon incorrigible sinners,
seeing the exercise of all his attributes must needs please him, else he
were not perfectly happy.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p28">65. Neither shall thy foot have rest - Ye shall have no
settlement in the land whither you are banished, but there you shall be
tossed about from place to place, and sold from person to person, or
Cain - like, wander about.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p29">66. Thy life shall hang in doubt - Either because thou
art in the hands of thy enemies that have power, and want no will, to
destroy thee: or because of the terrors of thy own mind, and the guilt
of thy conscience making thee to fear, even where no fear is.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxviii.ii-p30">68. Into Egypt - Which was literally fulfilled under
Titus, when multitudes of them were carried thither in ships, and sold
for slaves. And this expression seems to mind them of that time when
they went over the sea without ships, God miraculously drying up the sea
before them, which now they would have occasion sadly to remember. By
the way - Or, to the way. And the way seems not to be meant here of the
usual road-way from Canaan to Egypt, which was wholly by land, but to be
put for the end of the way or journey, even the land of Egypt, for to
this, and not to the road- way between Canaan and Egypt, agree the words
here following, whereof I speak unto thee, thou shalt see it, (that is,
Egypt) no more again. No man shall buy you - Either because the number
of your captives shall be so great, that the market shall be glutted
with you; or because you shall be so loathsome and contemptible that men
shall not be willing to have you for slaves. And this was the condition
of the Jews after the destruction of Jerusalem, as Josephus the Jew hath
left upon record. Let us all learn hence, to stand in awe and not to
sin. I have heard of a wicked man (says Mr. Henry) who on reading these
threatenings, was so enraged, that he tore the leaf out of his bible.
But to what purpose is it, to deface a copy, while the original remains
unchangeable? By which it is determined, that the wages of sin is death:
yea, a death more dreadful than all that is here spoken!</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIX" progress="51.17%" prev="ii.vi.xxviii.ii" next="ii.vi.xxix.i" id="ii.vi.xxix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXIX" id="ii.vi.xxix-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|29|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.29" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxix-p0.2">XXIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIX" progress="51.17%" prev="ii.vi.xxix" next="ii.vi.xxix.ii" id="ii.vi.xxix.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.i-p1">The preface of God's covenant, ver. 1. A recital of his
dealings with them, ver. 2-8. A solemn exhortation to keep covenant with
God, ver. 9-17. A severe threatning to them that break it, ver. 18-28.
The end of the revealed will of God, ver. 29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIX" progress="51.17%" prev="ii.vi.xxix.i" next="ii.vi.xxx" id="ii.vi.xxix.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p1">1. These are the terms or conditions upon which God hath
made, that is renewed his covenant with you. The covenant was but one in
substance, but various in the time and manner of its dispensation.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p2">4. Yet the Lord - That is, you have perceived and seen
them with the eyes of your body, but not with your minds and hearts; you
have not yet learned rightly to understand the word and works of God, so
as to know them for your good, and to make a right use of them, and to
comply with them: which he expresseth thus, the Lord hath not given you,
&amp;c. not to excuse their wickedness, but to direct them to whom they
must have recourse for a good understanding of God's works; and to
intimate that although the hearing ear, and the seeing eye, be the
workmanship of God, yet their want of his grace was their own fault, and
the just punishment of their former sins; their present case being like
theirs in Isaiah's time, who first shut their own eyes and ears that
they might not see and hear, and would not understand, and then by the
righteous judgment of God, had their eyes and ears closed that they
should not see and hear, and understand. God's readiness to do us good
in other things, is a plain evidence, that if we have not grace, that
best of gifts, 'tis our own fault and not his: he would have gathered
us, and we would not.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p3">6. Ye have not eaten bread - Common bread purchased by
your own money, or made by your own hands, but heavenly and angelical
bread. Neither drank wine - But only water out of the rock. The Lord -
Omnipotent and all-sufficient for your provision without the help of any
creatures, and your God in covenant with you who hath a true affection
to you, and fatherly care of you.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p4">11. Thy stranger - Such strangers as had embraced their
religion: all sorts of persons, yea, even the meanest of them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p5">12. Into covenant and into his oath - Into covenant,
confirmed by a solemn oath.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p6">13. That he may establish thee - Here is the summary of
that covenant whereof Moses was the mediator, and in the covenant
relation between God and them, all the precepts and promises of the
covenant are included. That they should be established for a people to
him, to fear, love, obey, and be devoted to him, and that he should be
to them a God, to make them holy and happy; and a due sense of the
relation we stand in to God as our God, and the obligation we are under
to him as his people, is enough to bring us to all the duties, and all
the comforts of the covenant. And does this covenant include nothing
spiritual? nothing that refers to eternity?</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p7">15. So also - With your posterity. For so the covenant
was made at first with Abraham and his seed, by which as God engaged
himself to continue the blessing of Abraham upon his posterity, so he
also engaged them to the same duties which were required of Abraham. So
it is even among men, where a king confers an estate upon a subject and
forever enjoy that benefit, are obliged to the same conditions. It may likewise
include those who were then constrained to be absent, by sickness, or
any necessary occasion. Nay one of the Chaldee pharaphrasts reads it,
all the generations that have been from the first days of the world, and
all that shall arise to the end of the whole world, stand with us here
this day. And so taking this covenant as a typical dispensation of the
covenant of grace, 'tis a noble testimony to the Mediator of that
covenant, who is the same yesterday, to day, and forx ever. 16. Egypt -
Where you have seen their idolatries, and learned too much of them, as
the golden calf shewed, and therefore have need to renew your covenant
with God; where also we were in dreadful bondage whence God alone hath
delivered us, to whom therefore we are deeply obliged, and have all
reason to renew our covenant with him. Through the nations - With what
hazard, if God had not appeared for us!</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p8">18. A root - An evil heart inclining you to such cursed
idolatry, and bringing forth bitter fruits.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p9">19. Of this curse - Of that oath where-in he swore he
would keep covenant with God, and that with a curse pronounced against
himself if he did not perform it. Bless himself - Flatter himself in his
own eyes, with vain hopes, as if God did not mind such things, and
either could not, or would not punish them. Peace - Safety and
prosperity. My own heart - Though I do not follow God's command, but my
own devices. To add drunkenness to thirst - The words may be rendered,
to add thirst to drunkenness, and so the sense may be, that when he hath
multiplied his sins, and made himself as it were drunk with them, yet he
is not satisfied therewith, but still whets his appetite, and provokes
his thirst after more, as drunkards often use means to make themselves
thirst after more drink.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p10">20. Shall smoke - Shall burn and break forth with flame
and smoke as it were from a furnace.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p11">21. Unto evil - Unto some peculiar and exemplary plague;
he will make him a monument of his displeasure to the whole land.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p12">23. Salt and burning - Is burnt up and made barren, as
with brimstone and salt.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p13">26. Whom God had not given to them - For their worship,
but hath divided them unto all nations, for their use and service. So he
speaks here of the sun and moon and stars, which were the principal gods
worshipped by the neighbouring nations.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxix.ii-p14">29. The secret things - Having mentioned the amazing
judgments of God upon the whole land and people of Israel, and
foreseeing the utter extirpation which would come upon them for their
wickedness, he breaks out into this pathetic exclamation, either to
bridle their curiosity, who would be apt to inquire into the time and
manner of so great an event; or to quiet his own mind, and satisfy the
scruples of others, who perceiving God to deal so severely with his own
people, when in the meantime he suffered those nations which were guilty
of grosser atheism and idolatry, might thence take occasion to deny his
providence or question the equity of his proceedings. To this he
answers, that the ways and judgments of God, tho' never unjust, are
often times hidden from us, unsearchable by our shallow capacities, and
matter for our admiration, not our enquiry. But the things which are
revealed by God and his word, are the proper object of our enquiries,
that thereby we may know our duty, and be kept from such terrible
calamities as these now mentioned.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXX" progress="51.28%" prev="ii.vi.xxix.ii" next="ii.vi.xxx.i" id="ii.vi.xxx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXX" id="ii.vi.xxx-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|30|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.30" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxx-p0.2">XXX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXX" progress="51.28%" prev="ii.vi.xxx" next="ii.vi.xxx.ii" id="ii.vi.xxx.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.i-p1">Promises upon their repentance, ver. 1-10. The
righteousness of faith set before them, ver. 11-14. Life and death
offered to their choice, ver. 15-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXX" progress="51.29%" prev="ii.vi.xxx.i" next="ii.vi.xxxi" id="ii.vi.xxx.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p1">1. The blessing - When thou art obedient. The curse -
When thou becomest rebellious.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p2">6. And the Lord - Or, For the Lord will circumcise thine
heart, will by his word and spirit change and purge thy heart from all
thine idolatry and wickedness, and incline thy heart to love him. God
will first convert and sanctify them, the fruit whereof shall be, that
they shall return and obey God's commandments, ver. 8, and then shall
prosper in all things, ver. 9. This promise principally respects the
times of the gospel, and the grace which was to be then imparted to all
Israel by Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p3">9. For good - Whereas thou did formerly receive these
mercies for thy hurt, now thou shalt have them for thy good, thy heart
shall be so changed that thou shalt not now abuse them, but employ them
to the service of God the giver. Over thee for good - To do thee good;
as he did rejoice to destroy thee.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p4">10. If thou wilt hearken - This is added to warn them
that they should not receive the grace of God in vain, and to teach them
that the grace of God doth not discharge man's obligation to his duty,
nor excuse him for the neglect of it. It is observable, that Moses calls
God, the Lord thy God twelve times in these ten verses. In the
threatnings of the former chapter, he is all along called the Lord, a
God of power, and the judge of all. But in the promises of this chapter,
the Lord thy God, a God of grace, and in covenant with thee.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p5">11. This commandment - The great command of loving and
obeying God, which is the sum of the law, of which yet he doth not here
speak, as it is in itself, but as it is molified and accompanied with
the grace of the gospel. The meaning is, that tho' the practice of God's
laws be now far from us, and above our strength, yet, considering the
advantage of gospel grace, whereby God enables us to do our duty, it is
near and easy to us, who believe. And so this well agrees with <scripRef passage="Rom. x. 6" id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Rom|10|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.10.6">Rom. x, 6</scripRef>, &amp;c. where St. Paul applies this place to the
righteousness of faith. Is not hidden - Hebrew. Is not too wonderful for
thee, not too hard for thee to know and do. The will of God, which is
but darkly manifested to other nations, <scripRef passage="Acts xvii. 27" id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p5.2" parsed="|Acts|17|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.17.27">Acts xvii, 27</scripRef>, is clearly and fully revealed unto thee: thou canst not
pretend ignorance or invincible difficulty.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p6">12. In heaven - Shut up there, but it hath been thence
delivered and published in thy hearing.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p7">13. Neither beyond the sea - The knowledge of this
commandment is not to be fetched from far distant places, to which
divers of the wise Heathens travelled for their wisdom; but it was
brought to thy very doors and ears, and declared to thee in this
wilderness.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p8">14. In thy mouth - Thou knowest it so well, that it is
the matter of thy common discourse. In thy heart - In thy mind, (as the
heart is very commonly taken) to understand and believe it. In a word,
the Law is plain and easy: but the gospel is much more so.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p9">19. Chuse life - They shall have life that chuse it: they
that chuse the favour of God, and communion with him, shall have what
they chuse. They that come short of life and happiness, must thank
themselves only. They had had them, if they had chosen them, when they
were put to their choice: but they die, because they will die.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxx.ii-p10">20. That thou mayest love the Lord thy God - Here he
shews them in short, what their duty is; To love God as the Lord, a
being most amiable, and as their God, a God in covenant with them: as an
evidence of their love, to obey his voice in every thing, and by
constancy in this love and obedience, to cleave to him all their days.
And what encouragement had they to do this? For he is thy life and the
length of thy days - He gives life, preserves life, restores life, and
prolongs it, by his power, tho' it be a frail life, and by his presence,
tho' it be a forfeited life. He sweetens life by his comforts, and
compleats all in life everlasting.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXI" progress="51.36%" prev="ii.vi.xxx.ii" next="ii.vi.xxxi.i" id="ii.vi.xxxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXXI" id="ii.vi.xxxi-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|31|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.31" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxxi-p0.2">XXXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXI" progress="51.36%" prev="ii.vi.xxxi" next="ii.vi.xxxi.ii" id="ii.vi.xxxi.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.i-p1">Moses encourages the people and Joshua, ver. 1-8. 23.
Delivers to the priests the law, to be read every seventh year, ver.
9-13. God informs Moses of his approaching death, and the future
apostasy of Israel, ver. 14-18. Orders him to write a song, which should
be a testimony against them, ver. 19-22. Moses gives the law to the
Levites to lay up beside the ark, and bids them assemble the people to
hear his song, ver. 24-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXI" progress="51.36%" prev="ii.vi.xxxi.i" next="ii.vi.xxxii" id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p1">1. Went and spake - Continued to speak, an usual Hebrew
phrase.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p2">2. Go out and come in - Perform the office of a leader or
governor, because the time of my death approaches.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p3">9. This law - Largely so called, the whole law or
doctrine delivered unto Moses contained in these five books. To the
priests - That they might keep it carefully and religiously, and bring
it forth upon occasion, and read it, and instruct the people out of it.
The elders - Who were assistants to the priests, to take care that the
law should be kept, and read, and observed.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p4">10. The year of release - When they were freed from debts
and troubles, and cares of worldly matters, and thereby fitter to attend
on God and his service.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p5">11. Thou shalt read - Thou shalt cause it to be read by
the priest or Levites; for he could not read it himself in the hearing
of all Israel, but this was to be done by several persons, and so the
people met in several congregations.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p6">12. Together - Not in one place. But into divers
assemblies or synagogues. Women who hereby are required to go to
Jerusalem at this solemnity, as they were permitted to do in other
solemnities. Children - Such of them as could understand, as appears
from <scripRef passage="Neh. viii. 2, 3" id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Neh|8|2|8|3" osisRef="Bible:Neh.8.2-Neh.8.3">Neh. viii, 2, 3</scripRef>, the pious Jews doubtless read it daily in their houses, and
Moses of old time was read in the synagogues every sabbath day. But once
in seven years, the law was thus to be read in public, to magnify it and
make it honourable.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p7">14. Give him a charge - Immediately from myself for his
greater encouragement, and to gain him more authority with the
people.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p8">16. The strangers of the land - That is, of the
Canaanites, who will be turned out of their possessions, and become as
strangers in their own land. This aggravates their folly to worship such
gods as could neither preserve their friends, nor annoy their
enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p9">17. Hide my face - Withdraw my favour and help. Whatever
outward troubles we are in if we have but the light of God's
countenance, we are safe. But if God hide his face from us then we are
undone.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p10">19. Write this song - Which is contained chap. xxxii,
1-43, and is put into a song that it may be better learned, and more
fixed in their minds and memories. Put it in their mouths - Cause them
to learn it, and sing it one to another, to oblige them to more
circumspection. A witness - Of my kindness in giving them so many
blessings, of my patience in bearing so long with them, of my clemency
in giving them such fair and plain warnings, and my justice in punishing
such an incorrigible people.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p11">21. Their imaginations - Inclinations to Idolatry, which
they do not check, as they ought; and some of them do not only cherish
it in their hearts, but as far as they can and dare, secretly practice
it, as may be gathered from <scripRef passage="Amos v. 25" id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Amos|5|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Amos.5.25">Amos v, 25</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 43" id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p11.2" parsed="|Acts|7|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.43">Acts vii, 43</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p12">25. The Levites - The priests, ver. 9, who also were
Levites.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p13">26. Take this book - Probably the very same book, which
(after having been some way misplaced) was found in the house of the
Lord, in the days of Josiah, and publickly read by the king himself, for
a witness against a people, who were then almost ripe for ruin. In the
side - In the outside, in a little chest fixed to it, for nothing but
the tables of stone were contained in the ark, <scripRef passage="1 Kings viii. 9" id="ii.vi.xxxi.ii-p13.1" parsed="|1Kgs|8|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.8.9">1 Kings
viii, 9</scripRef>, here it was kept for greater security and reverence. A
witness against thee - Against thy people, to whom he turns his speech
that they might be the more affected with it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXII" progress="51.42%" prev="ii.vi.xxxi.ii" next="ii.vi.xxxii.i" id="ii.vi.xxxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXXII" id="ii.vi.xxxii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|32|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxxii-p0.2">XXXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXII" progress="51.42%" prev="ii.vi.xxxii" next="ii.vi.xxxii.ii" id="ii.vi.xxxii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.i-p1">The song of Moses contains the preface, ver. 1, 2. A high
character of God, ver. 3-6. A recital of the great things God had done
for them, and as their carriage toward him, ver. 7-18. A prediction of
judgments for their aggravated impieties, ver. 19-35. A promise of
vengeance upon their enemies, and deliverance for a remnant, ver. 36-43.
An exhortation annext, ver. 44-47. Orders given to Moses, to go up to
the mount and die, ver. 48-52.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXII" progress="51.43%" prev="ii.vi.xxxii.i" next="ii.vi.xxxiii" id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p1">1. O heavens, O earth - You lifeless and senseless
creatures, which he calls upon partly to accuse the stupidity of Israel,
that were more dull of hearing than these: and partly as witnesses of
the truth of his sayings and the justice of God's proceedings against
them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p2">2. As the rain - Look what effect rain and dew have upon
herbs and grass which they make fresh and fragrant and growing, the same
effect may my discourse have upon your hearts, that is, to make them
soft and pliable and fruitful.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p3">3. The name of the Lord - His glorious excellencies and
righteous actions, by which he hath made himself known as a man is known
by his name, and by which it will appear both that there is no blame to
be laid upon him whatsoever befalls you, and that it is gross madness to
forsake such a God for dumb idols. Ascribe ye - As I am about to publish
the majesty and glory of God, so do you also acknowledge it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p4">4. A rock - As for the stability of his nature, and
invincibleness of his power, so also for his fixedness and immutability
in his counsels and promises and ways; so that is there shall be a sad
change in your affairs, remember that this proceeds from yourselves and
from the change of your ways towards God, and not from God, in whom
there is no variableness or shadow of change, <scripRef passage="James i. 17" id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Jas|1|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.1.17">James i, 17</scripRef>. His work - All his works and actions are unblameable,
perfect, wise and righteous. His ways - All his administrations in the
world and particularly with you are managed with wisdom and justice. A
God of truth - Constant to his promises: you cannot accuse him of any
unfaithfulness to this day.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p5">5. They - The Israelites. Their spot - The wickedness
with which they are stained, is not of his children - Plainly shews they
are not his children, but the devil's. God's children have no such spot.
Indeed this text does not affirm, they have any spot at all. Perverse -
Froward and untractable: Crooked - Irregular and disorderly.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p6">6. O foolish people and unwise! - Fools and double fools!
Fools indeed, to disoblige one, on whom you so entirely depend! Who hath
bewitched you! To forsake your own mercies for lying vanities! Bought
thee - That hath redeemed thee from Egyptian bondage. Made thee - Not
only in a general by creation, but in a peculiar manner by making thee
his peculiar people. Established - That is, renewed and confirmed his
favour to thee, and not taken it away, which thou hast often provoked
him to do.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p7">7. The days of old - The events of ancient days or former
ages, and thou wilt find that I had a respect unto thee not only in
Abraham's time, but long before it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p8">8. Their inheritance - When God by his providence
allotted the several parts of the world to several people, which was
done <scripRef passage="Gen. x. 1-32" id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Gen|10|1|10|32" osisRef="Bible:Gen.10.1-Gen.10.32">Gen.
x, 1-32</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Gen. xi. 1-9" id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p8.2" parsed="|Gen|11|1|11|9" osisRef="Bible:Gen.11.1-Gen.11.9">Gen. xi, 1-9</scripRef>. When he separated - Divided them in their languages and
habitations according to their families. He set the bounds - That is, he
disposed of the several lands and limits of the people so as to reserve
a sufficient place for the great numbers of the people of Israel. And
therefore he so guided the hearts of several people, that the posterity
of Canaan, which was accursed of God, and devoted to ruin, should be
seated in that country which God intended for the children of Israel,
that so when their iniquities were ripe, they might be rooted out, and
the Israelites come in their stead.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p9">9. His people - It is no wonder God had so great a regard
to this people, for he chose them out of all mankind to be his peculiar
portion.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p10">10. He found him - Not by chance, but as it were looking
out and seeking for him. He did indeed manifest himself to him in Egypt,
but it was in the wilderness at Sinai, God found him in an eminent
manner, and revealed his will to him, and entered into covenant with
him, and imparted himself and his grace and blessing to him. By this
word he also signifies both their lost condition in themselves, and that
their recovery was not from themselves, but only from God who sought and
found them out by his grace. In the waste howling wilderness - In a
place destitute of all the necessaries and comforts of life, which also
was a type of that desolate and comfortless condition in which all men
are before the grace of God finds them out; where instead of the voices
of men, is nothing heard but the howlings and yellings of ravenous birds
and beasts. He led them - He conducted them frons place to place by his
cloudy pillar and providence. Or, he compassed him about, by his
provident care, watching over him and preserving him on every side. As
the apple of his eye - As men use to keep the apple of their eye, that
is, with singular care and diligence, this being as a most tender, so a
most useful part.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p11">11. Her nest - Her young ones in the nest; which she by
her cry and motion provoketh to fly. Her wings - As preparing herself to
fly. On her wings - Or, as on her wings, that is, gently, and tenderly
and safely too, as if she carried them not in her claws for fear of
hurting them, but upon her wings. Some say, the eagle doth usually carry
her young ones upon her wings.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p12">12. Did lead them - When they were shut up in Egypt as in
their nest whence they durst not venture to fly nor stir, he taught and
encouraged and enabled them to fly out from that bondage, he dealt
tenderly with them, bearing with their infirmities, keeping them from
all harms. With him - To assist him at that work or to deliver them. The
more unworthy they in giving to idols a share in that worship which they
owe to God only.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p13">13. The high places - To conquer their strongest holds,
which often are in the mountains, and their cities fenced with walls of
greatest height and strength. To ride upon, in scripture phrase, is to
subdue or conquer. Out of the rock - This being a land flowing with
honey, where the bees made honey in the holes of rocks, or in the trees
that grew upon or among the rocks. Out of the flinty rocks - The
olive-trees grow and bear most fruit in rocky or hilly places.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p14">14. Fat of lambs - For though the fat wherewith the
inward parts were covered was not to be eaten by them, but offered to
God, yet that fat which was mixed with the flesh they might eat, as the
Jewish doctors note. Basham - A place famous for excellent cattle. Fat
of kidneys of wheat - With the finest of the grains of wheat; compared
to kidneys for their shape and largeness.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p15">15. Jeshurun - Israel whom he calls right or upright, (as
the word signifies) partly by way of instruction to mind them what they
professed and ought to be; and partly by way of exprobration, to shew
them what a shame it was to degenerate so much from their name and
profession. Kicked - As well fed cattle use to do: he grew insolent and
rebellious against God and against his word and spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p16">16. To jealousy - To anger and fury, for jealousy is the
rage of a man. And withall it implies the ground of his anger, their
falseness to God whom they had accepted as their husband, and their
spiritual whoredom with other gods.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p17">17. Unto devils - Unto idols, which the devils brought
into the world in opposition to God, in and by which the devils often
manifested themselves to men, and gave them answers, and received their
worship. The Gentiles pretended to worship God in those idols, and the
devils which inspired them, deluded the nations with pretenses that they
were a sort of lower gods. Moses takes off this mark, and shews the
Israelites that these pretended gods were really devils, and therefore
that it was the height of madness to honour or worship them. Not to God
- For God utterly rejected those sacrifices which they offered to him
together with idols. They knew not - Or, who never knew them, that is,
never shewed any kindness to them, or did them any good: New gods - Not
simply or absolutely, for some of these had been worshipped for many
generations, but comparatively to the true God, who is the ancient of
days, chap. vii, 9, and who was worshipped from the beginning of the
world. Feared not - Served not, worshipped not.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p18">18. Of the rock - Of God, one of whose titles this is, or
of Christ, who is called the rock, <scripRef passage="1 Cor. x. 4" id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p18.1" parsed="|1Cor|10|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Cor.10.4">1 Cor. x, 4</scripRef>, whom the Israelites tempted.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p19">19. His sons and daughters - Such they were by calling
and profession.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p20">20. I will see - I will make them and others see, what
the fruit of such actions shall be. No faith - No fidelity: perfidious,
that have broken their covenant so solemnly made with me.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p21">21. I will move them to jealousy with those that are not
a people - With the Heathen nations, who are none of my people, who
scarce deserve the name of a people, as being without the knowledge and
fear of God, which is the foundation of all true policy and government,
and many of them destitute of all government, laws and order. And yet
these people I will take in your stead, receive them and reject you;
which, when it came to pass how desperately did it provoke the Jews to
jealousy? A foolish nation - So the Gentiles were both in the opinion of
the Jews and in truth and reality, notwithstanding all their pretenses
to wisdom, there being nothing more foolish or brutish than the worship
of idols.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p22">22. A fire is kindled - Great and grievous judgments
shall be inflicted, which often come under the name of fire. Are they
proud of their plenty? It shall burn up the increase of the earth. Are
they confident of their strength? It shall destroy the very foundations
of the mountains. It shall burn unto the lowest hell: it shall bring
them to the very depth of misery in this world, which yet will he but a
faint resemblance of their endless misery in the next.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p23">23. Spend mine arrows - Even empty my quiver, and send
upon them all my plagues, which, like arrows shot by a skilful and
strong hand, shall speedily reach and certainly hit and mortally wound
them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p24">24. With hunger - With famine, which burns and parches
the inward parts, and make the face black as a coal, <scripRef passage="Lam. iv. 8" id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p24.1" parsed="|Lam|4|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lam.4.8">Lam. iv, 8</scripRef>. Burning heat - From fevers or carbuncles, or other
inflaming distempers.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p25">27. The wrath - Their rage against me, as it is
expressed, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxxvii. 28, 29" id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p25.1" parsed="|Isa|37|28|37|29" osisRef="Bible:Isa.37.28-Isa.37.29">Isaiah
xxxvii, 28, 29</scripRef>, their furious reproaches against my name, as if I were
cruel to my people or unable to deliver them. The fear hereof is
ascribed to God after the manner of men. Strangely - Insolenty and
arrogantly above what they used to do.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p26">28. Void of counsel - Their enemies are foolish people,
and therefore make so false and foolish a judgment upon things.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p27">29. They - Israel. Latter end - What their end will be,
and that tho' God spare them long, yet at last judgment will certainly
overtake them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p28">30. One - Israelite. Their rock - Their God, who was
their refuge and defense. Sold them - Namely, for bond-slaves, had given
themselves up into their enemies hands. Shut them up - As it were in the
net which their enemies had laid for them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p29">31. Being Judges - Who by their dear bought experience
have been forced to acknowledge that our God was far stronger than they
and their false gods together.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p30">32. For - As if he had said, This is the reason why their
rock hath shut them up. Their vine is of the vine of Sodom - The people
of Israel, which I planted as a choice vine, are now degenerated and
become like the vine of Sodom, their principles and practices are all
corrupt and abominable. Bitter - Their fruits are loathsome to me,
mischievous to others, and at last will be pernicious to themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p31">34. This - All their wickedness mentioned before. My long
suffering towards them may make them think I have forgotten their sins,
but I remember them punctually, they are sealed up as in a bag, <scripRef passage="Job xiv. 17" id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p31.1" parsed="|Job|14|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.14.17">Job xiv, 17</scripRef>, and as men seal up their treasures.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p32">35. Their feet shall slide - They who now think they
stand fast and unmoveable, shall fall into utter destruction. In due
time - Though not so soon as some may expect, yet in that time when it
shall be most proper, when they have filled up the measure of their
sins. At hand - Hebrew. is near. So the scripture often speaks of those
things which are at many hundred years distance, to signify, that though
they may be afar off as to our measures of time, yet in God's account
they are near, they are as near as may be, when the measure of their
sins is once full, the judgment shall not be deferred.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p33">36. For - Or, nevertheless, having spoken of the dreadful
calamity which would come upon his people, he now turns his discourse
into a more comfortable strain, and begins to shew that after God had
sorely chastised his people, he would have mercy upon them and turn
their captivity. Judge his people - Shall plead their cause, shall
protect and deliver them. Repent - Of the evils he hath brought upon
them. None shut up - Either in their strong cities or castles or other
hiding places, or in the enemies hands or prisons, whence there might be
some hope or possibility of redemption; and none left, as the poor and
contemptible people are neglected and usually left by the conquerors in
the conquered land, but all seem to be cut off and destroyed.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p34">37. He shall say - The Lord, before he deliver his
people, will first convince them of their former folly in forsaking him
and following idols.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p35">38. Which did eat - That is, to whom you offered
sacrifices and oblations after the manner of the Gentiles. Help you - If
they can.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p36">39. See now - Learn by your own sad experience what vain
and impotent things idols are. I am he - The only true, omnipotent and
irresistible God.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p37">40. I lift up my hand - I solemnly swear, that I will do
what here follows. I live - As sure as I live.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p38">41. If I whet my sword - If once I begin to prepare for
war and for the execution of my sentence. Judgment - Of the instruments
of judgment, of the weapons of war. A metaphor from warriors, that take
their weapons into their hand, when they intend to fight.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p39">42. Captives - Whom my sword hath sorely wounded, though
not utterly killed. From the beginning - When once I begin to revenge
myself and my people upon mine and their enemies, I will go on and make
a full end.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p40">43. Rejoice - He calls upon the nations to rejoice and
bless God for his favours, and especially for the last wonderful
deliverance which shall be given to the Jews, when they shall be
converted to the gospel in the last days; which they have all reason to
do, because of that singular advantage which all nations will have at
that time and upon that occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p41">44. He and Hoshea - Or Joshua. Probably Moses spoke it to
as many as could hear him, while Josh. in another assembly at the same
time delivered it to as many as his voice would reach. Thus Joshua, as
well as Moses, would be a witness against them, if ever they forsook
God.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p42">47. Not vain - It is not an unprofitable or contemptible
work I advise you to, but well worthy of your most serious care.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p43">48. That self-same day - Now he had finished his work,
why should he desire to live a day longer? He had indeed formerly
desired and prayed, that he might go over Jordan: but now he is entirely
satisfied, and saith no more of that matter.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p44">49. Nebo - A ridge or top of the mountains of Abarim.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p45">51. Because ye trespassed - God reminds him of the sin he
had committed long before. It is good for the holiest of men to die
repenting, even of their early sins.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxii.ii-p46">52. Yet thou shalt see the land - And see it as the
earnest of that better country, which is only seen with the eye of
faith. What is death to him who has a believing prospect and a steadfast
hope of eternal life?</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIII" progress="51.70%" prev="ii.vi.xxxii.ii" next="ii.vi.xxxiii.i" id="ii.vi.xxxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXXIII" id="ii.vi.xxxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|33|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.33" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxxiii-p0.2">XXXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXIII" progress="51.70%" prev="ii.vi.xxxiii" next="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.i-p1">The blessing of Moses. He pronounces them all blessed, in
what God had done for them, already, ver. 1-5. He pronounces a blessing
upon each tribe, ver. 6-25. He pronounces them all in general blessed,
on account of what God would be to them, and do for them, if they were
obedient, ver. 26-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXIII" progress="51.71%" prev="ii.vi.xxxiii.i" next="ii.vi.xxxiv" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p1">1. Moses blessed Israel - He is said to bless them, by
praying to God with faith for his blessing upon them; and by foretelling
the blessings which God would confer upon them. And Moses calls himself
here the man of God, that is, the servant or prophet of God, to acquaint
them that the following prophecies were not his own inventions, but
divine inspirations. The children of Israel - The several tribes: only
Simeon is omitted, either in detestation of their parent Simeon's bloody
carriage, for which Jacob gives that tribe a curse rather than a
blessing, in <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 5-7" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|49|5|49|7" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.5-Gen.49.7">Gen. xlix, 5-7</scripRef>. Or, because that tribe had no distinct inheritance, but was
to have its portion in the tribe of Judah, <scripRef passage="Josh. xix. 1" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Josh|19|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.19.1">Josh. xix, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p2">2. The Lord came - Namely, to the Israelites, manifested
himself graciously and gloriously among them. From Sinai - Beginning at
Sinai, where the first appearance of God was, and so going on with them
to Seir and Paran. And rose up - He appeared or shewed himself, as the
sun doth when it riseth. From Seir - From the mountain or land of Edom,
to which place the Israelites came, <scripRef passage="Num. xx. 14" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Num|20|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.20.14">Num. xx, 14</scripRef>, &amp;c. and from thence God led them on towards the land of
promise, and then gloriously appeared for them in subduing Sihon and Og
before them. But because the land of Edom is sometimes taken more
largely, and so reacheth even to the Red-sea, and therefore Mount Sinai
was near to it, and because Paran was also near Sinai, being the next
station into which they came from the wilderness of Sinai: all this
verse may belong to God's appearance in Mount Sinai, where that glorious
light which shone upon Mount Sinai directly, did in all probability
scatter its beams into adjacent parts, such as Seir and Paran were. And
if so, this is only a poetical expression of the same thing in divers
words, and God coming or rising or shining from or to or in Sinai and
Seir and Paran note one and the same illustrious action of God appearing
there with ten thousands of his saints or holy angels, and giving a
fiery law to them. Paran - A place where God eminently manifested his
presence and goodness both in giving the people flesh which they
desired, and in appointing the seventy elders and pouring forth his
spirit upon them. With ten thousands of saints - That is, with a great
company of holy angels, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxviii. 17" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Ps|68|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.68.17">Psalm
lxviii, 17</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Dan. vii. 10" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p2.3" parsed="|Dan|7|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.7.10">Dan. vii, 10</scripRef>, which attended upon him in this great and glorious work of
giving the law, as may be gathered from <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 53" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p2.4" parsed="|Acts|7|53|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.53">Acts
vii, 53</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Gal. iii. 19" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p2.5" parsed="|Gal|3|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gal.3.19">Gal. iii, 19</scripRef>. From his right hand - Which both wrote the law and gave it
to men. An allusion to men who ordinarily write and give gifts with
their right hand. A fiery law - The law is called fiery, because it is
of a fiery nature purging and searching and inflaming, to signify that
fiery wrath which it inflicteth upon sinners for the violation of it,
and principally because it was delivered out of the midst of the
fire.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p3">3. The people - The tribes of Israel. The sense is, this
law, though delivered with fire and smoke and thunder, which might seem
to portend nothing but hatred and terror, yet in truth was given to
Israel, in great love, as being the great mean of their temporal and
eternal salvation. Yea, he, embraced the people, and laid them in his
bosom! so the word signifies, which speaks not only the dearest love,
but the most tender and careful protection. All God's saints or holy
ones, that is, his people, were in thy hand, that is, under God's care
to protect, direct and govern them. These words are spoken to God: the
change of persons, his and thy, is most frequent in the Hebrew tongue.
This clause may farther note God's kindness to Israel, in upholding them
when the fiery law was delivered, which was done with so much terror
that not only the people were ready to sink under it, but even Moses did
exceedingly fear and quake. But God sustained both Moses and the people,
in or by his hand, whereby he in a manner covered them that no harm
might come to them. At thy feet - Like scholars to receive instructions.
He alludes to the place where the people waited when the law was
delivered, which was at the foot of the mount. Everyone - Of the people
will receive or submit to thy instructions and commands. This may
respect either, the peoples promise when they heard the law, that they
would hear and do all that was commanded. Or, their duty to do so.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p4">4. Moses - He speaks this of himself in the third person,
which is very usual in the Hebrew language. The law is called their
inheritance, because the obligation of it was hereditary, passing from
parents to their children, and because this was the best part of their
inheritance, the greatest of all those gifts which God bestowed upon
them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p5">5. He was king in Jeshurun - Moses was their king not in
title, but in reality, being under God, their supreme governor, and law
giver. Gathered together - When the princes and people met together for
the management of public affairs, Moses was owned by them as their king
and lawgiver. 6. Let Reuben live - Though Reuben deserve to be cut off
or greatly diminished and obscured, according to Jacob's prediction, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 4" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|49|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.4">Gen. xlix, 4</scripRef>, yet God will spare them and give them a name and portion
among the tribes of Israel, and bless them with increase of their
numbers. All the ancient paraphrasts refer this to the other world, so
far were they from expecting temporal blessings only. Let Reuben live in
life eternal, says Onkelos, and not die the second death. Let Reuben
live in this world, so Jonathan and the Jerusalem Targum, and not die
that death which the wicked die in the world to come.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p6">7. Hear, Lord - God will hear his prayer for the
accomplishment of those great things promised to that tribe, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 8-12" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Gen|49|8|49|12" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.8-Gen.49.12">Gen. xlix, 8-12</scripRef>. This implies the delays and difficulties Judah would meet
with, that would drive him to his prayers, which would be with success.
Unto his people - When he shall go forth to battle against his enemies
and shall fall fiercely upon them, as was foretold, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 8, 9" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Gen|49|8|49|9" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.8-Gen.49.9">Gen.
xlix, 8, 9</scripRef>. Bring him back with honour and victory, to his people, to
the rest of his tribe who were left at home when their brethren went to
battle: and to his brethren the other tribes of Israel. Let his hands be
sufficient for him - This tribe shall be so numerous and potent that it
shall suffice to defend itself without any aid, either from foreign
nations or from other tribes; as appeared when this tribe alone was able
to grapple with nine or ten of the other tribes. From his enemies - Thou
wilt preserve this tribe in a special manner, so that his enemies shall
not be able to ruin it, as they will do other tribes, and that for the
sake of the Messiah who shall spring out of it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p7">8. Let thy Urim - The Thummim and the Urim, which are
thine, O Lord by special institution and consecration, (by which he
understands the ephod in which they were put, and the high priesthood,
to which they were appropriated, and withal the gifts and graces
signified by the Urim and Thummim, and necessary for the discharge of
that high-office) shall be with thy holy one, that is, with that priest,
whom thou hast consecrated to thyself, and who is holy in a more
peculiar manner than all the people were; that is, the priesthood shall
be confined to and continued in Aaron's family. Whom thou didst prove -
Altho' thou didst try him, and rebuke him, yet thou didst not take away
the priesthood from him. At Massah - Not at that Massah mentioned <scripRef passage="Exod. xvii. 7" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Exod|17|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.17.7">Exod. xvii,
7</scripRef>, which is also called Meribah, but at that other Meribah, <scripRef passage="Num. xx. 13" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Num|20|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.20.13">Num.
xx, 13</scripRef>. Thou didst strive - Whom thou didst reprove and
chastise.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p8">9. I have not seen him - That is, I have no respect unto
them. The sense is, who followed God and his command fully, and executed
the judgment enjoined by God without any respect of persons, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxii. 26, 27" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Exod|32|26|32|27" osisRef="Bible:Exod.32.26-Exod.32.27">Exod. xxxii, 26, 27</scripRef>. They kept thy covenant - When the rest broke their covenant
with God by that foul sin of idolatry with the calf, that tribe kept
themselves pure from that infection, and adhered to God and his
worship.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p9">11. His substance - Because he hath no inheritance of his
own and therefore wholly depends upon thy blessing. The work of his
hands - All his holy administrations, which he fitly calls the work of
his hands, because a great part of the service of the Levites and
priests was done by the labour of their hand and body, whereas the
service of evangelical ministers is more spiritual and heavenly. Smite -
He pray's thus earnestly for them, because he foresaw they who were to
teach and reprove, and chastise others would have many enemies, and
because they were under God, the great preservers and upholders of
religion, and their enemies were the enemies of religion itself.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p10">12. Of Benjamin - Benjamin is put next to Levi, because
the temple, where the work of the Levites lay, was upon the edge of the
lot of this tribe. And 'tis put before Joseph, because of the dignity of
Jerusalem, (part of which was in this lot) above Samaria, which was in
the tribe of Ephraim: likewise because Benjamin adhered to the house of
David and to the temple of God, when the rest of the tribes deserted
both. The beloved of the Lord - So called in allusion to their father
Benjamin who was the beloved of his father Jacob; and because of the
kindness of God to this tribe which appeared both in this, that they
dwelt in the best part of the land, as Josephus affirms, and in the
following privilege. Shall dwell in safety by him - Shall have his lot
nigh to God's temple, which was both a singular comfort and safeguard to
him. Shall cover - Shall protect that tribe continually while they
cleave to him. He - The Lord shall dwell, that is, his temple shall be
placed, between his shoulders, that is, in his portion, or between his
border's as the word shoulder is often used. And this was truly the
situation of the temple, on both sides whereof was Benjamin's portion.
And though Mount Zion was in the tribe of Judah, yet mount Moriah, on
which the temple was built, was in the tribe of Benjamin.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p11">13. And of Joseph - Including both Ephraim and Manasseh.
In Jacob's blessing that of Joseph's is the largest. And so it is here.
His land - His portion shall be endowed with choice blessings from God.
Of heaven - That is, the precious fruits of the earth brought forth by
the influences of heaven, the warmth of the sun, and the rain which God
will send from heaven. The deep - The springs of water bubbling out of
the earth: perhaps it may likewise refer to the great deep, the abyss of
waters, which is supposed to be contained in the earth.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p12">14. By the sun - Which opens and warms the earth,
cherishes and improves and in due time ripens the seeds and fruits of
it. The moon - Which by its moisture refreshes and promotes them.
Hebrew. Of the moons, or months, that is, which it bringeth forth in the
several months or seasons of the year.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p13">15. The chief things - That is, the excellent fruits, as
grapes, olives, figs, &amp;c. which delight in mountains, growing upon,
or the precious minerals contained in, their mountains and hills called
ancient and lasting, that is, such as have been from the beginning of
the world, and are likely to continue to the end of it, in opposition to
those hills or mounts which have been cast up by man.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p14">16. And for - And in general for all the choice fruits
which the land produceth in all the parts of it, whither hills or
valleys. Fulness thereof - That is, the plants and cattle and all
creatures that grow, increase, and flourish in it. The good will - For
all other effects of the good will and kindness of God who not long
since did for a time dwell or appear in the bush to me in order to the
relief of his people, <scripRef passage="Exod. iii. 2" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Exod|3|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3.2">Exod. iii, 2</scripRef>. Of Joseph - That is, of Joseph's posterity. Him that was
separated from his brethren -- his brethren separated him from them by
making him a slave, and God distinguished him from them by making him a
prince. The preceeding words might be rendered, My dweller in the bush.
That was an appearance of the divine majesty to Moses only, in token of
his particular favour. Many a time had God appeared to Moses; but now he
is just dying, he seems to have the most pleasing remembrance, of the
first time that he saw the visions of the Almighty. It was here God
declared himself the God of Abraham, Isaac and Jacob, and so confirmed
the promise made to the father, that promise which our Lord shews,
reaches as far as the resurrection and eternal life.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p15">17. His glory is like the firstling of his bullock - Or
young bull, which is a stately creature, and was therefore formerly used
as an emblem of royal majesty. This seems to note the kingdom which
Ephraim should obtain in Jeroboam and his successors. His horns - His
strength and power shall be very great. The people - All that shall
oppose him, and particularly the Canaanites. The ten thousands - Of the
land of Canaan. Though Manasseh be now more numerous, yet Ephraim shall
shortly outstrip him, as was foretold <scripRef passage="Gen. xlviii. 17-19" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Gen|48|17|48|19" osisRef="Bible:Gen.48.17-Gen.48.19">Gen. xlviii, 17-19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p16">18. Rejoice - Thou shalt prosper and have cause of
rejoicing. In thy going out -</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p17">1. To war, as this phrase is often
used.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p18">2. To sea, in way of traffick, because
their portion lay near the sea. And in both respects his course is
opposite to that of Issachar, who was a lover of peace and pasturage. He
is here joined with Zebulun, both because they were brethren by father
and mother too, and because their possessions lay near together. In thy
tents - Thou shalt give thyself to the management of laud and cattle,
living quietly in thy own possessions.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p19">19. They - Zebulun of whom Moses takes more special
notice. And so having dispatched Issachar in two words, he returns to
Zebulun. The people - the Gentiles, either those of Galilee, which was
called Galilee of the Gentiles, who were their neighbours; or people of
other nations, with whom they had commerce, which they endeavoured to
improve in persuading them to worship the true God. The mountain - That
is, to the temple, which Moses knew was to be seated upon a mountain.
Sacrifices of righteousness - Such as God requires. Their trafficking
abroad with Heathen nations shall not make them forget their duty at
home, nor shall their distance from the place of sacrifice hinder them
from coming to it to discharge that duty. Of the abundance of the sea -
They shall grow rich by the traffick of the sea, and shall consecrate
themselves and their riches to God. Hid in the sand - Such precious
things as either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p20">1. Are contained in the sand of the sea and
rivers, in which sometimes there is mixed a considerable quantity of
gold and silver. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p21">2. Such as grow in the sea, or are fetched
from the sandy bottom of it, as pearls, coral, ambergrease. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p22">3. Such as being cast into the sea by
shipwreck are cast upon the shore by the workings of the sea. It were
well, if the enlargement of our trade with foreign countries, were made
to contribute to the spreading of the gospel.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p23">20. Enlargeth - That bringeth him out of his straits amid
troubles, which he was often engaged in, because he was encompassed with
potent enemies. As a lion - Safe and secure from his enemies, and
terrible to them when they rouse and molest him. Teareth the arm -
Utterly destroys his enemies, both the head, the seat of the crown,
their dignity and principality, and the arm, the subject of strength and
instrument of action; both chief princes, and their subjects.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p24">21. The first part - The first fruits of the land of
promise, the country of Sihon, which was first conquered, which he is
said to provide for himself, because he desired and obtained it of
Moses. Of the law-giver - Of Moses, whose portion this is called, either
because this part of the land beyond Jordan was the only part of the
land which Moses was permitted to enter upon: or because it was given
him by Moses, whereas the portions beyond Jordan were given to the
several tribes by Joshua according to the direction of the lot. Seated -
Hebrew. hid or protected: for their wives and children were secured in
their cities, while many of their men went over to the war in Canaan. He
came - He went, or he will go, to the war in Canaan, with the princes,
or captains, or rulers of the people of Israel, that is, under their
command and conduct, as indeed they did; or with the first of the
people; or, in the front of the people, as the Syriack renders it; for
this tribe and their brethren whose lot fell beyond Jordan, were to
march into Canaan before their brethren. He executed - The just judgment
of God against the Canaanites, as the rest of the Israelites did.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p25">22. A lion's whelp - Courageous, and generous, and
strong, and successful against his enemies. Which leapeth - From Bashan,
because there were many and fierce lions in those parts, whence they
used to come forth and leap upon the prey. Or this may refer either to
the particular victories obtained by Samson, who was of the tribe of
Daniel, or to a more general achievement of that tribe, when a party of
them surprised Laish, which lay in the farthest part of the land of
Canaan from them. And the mountain of Bashan lying not far from that
city, from whence they probably made their descent upon it, thus leaping
from Basham.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p26">23. Satisfied with favour - With the favour of God. That
only is the favour that satisfies the soul. They are happy indeed that
have the favour of God; and they shall have it, that place their
satisfaction in it. And full with the blessing of the Lord - Not Only
with corn, wine and oil, the fruit of the blessing, but with the
blessing itself, the grace of God, according to his promise and
covenant. Possess thou the west and the south - Or, the sea and the
south. This is not to be understood of the place, that his lot should
fall there, for he was rather in the east and north of the land; but of
the pleasures and commodities of the west or of the sea, which were
conveyed to him from his neighbour Zebulun; and of the south, that is,
from the southern tribes and parts of Canaan, which were brought to him
down the river Jordan, and both sorts of commodities were given him in
exchange for the fruitful rich soil which he had in great abundance.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p27">24. Let Asher - Who carries blessedness in his very name,
be blessed with children - He shall have numerous, strong and healthful
children. Acceptable to his brethren -- by his sweet disposition and
winning carriage. In oil - He shall have such plenty of oil that he may
not only wash his face, but his feet also in it.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p28">25. Iron and brass - The mines of iron and copper, which
were in their portion, whence Sidon their neighbour was famous among the
Heathens for its plenty of brass, and Sarepta is thought to have its
name from the brass and iron which were melted there in great quantity.
Thy strength shall be - Thy strength shall not be diminished with age,
but thou shalt have the vigour of youth even in thine old age: thy tribe
shalt grow stronger and stronger.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p29">26. There us none - These are the last words that ever
Moses wrote, perhaps the greatest writer that ever lived upon the earth.
And this man of God, who had as much reason to know both as ever any
mere man had, with his last breath magnifies both the God of Israel, and
the Israel of God. Unto the God of Jeshurun, who to help thee, rideth
upon the heaven, and with the greatest state and magnificence, on the
sky. Riding on the heaven denotes the greatness and glory, in which he
manifests himself to the upper world, and the use he makes of the
influences of heaven and the products of the clouds, in bringing to pass
his own counsels in this lower world. All these he manages and directs,
as a man doth the horse he rides on.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p30">27. The eternal God - He who was before all worlds, and
will be, when time shall be no more: Is thy refuge - Or, thy habitation
or mansion-house (so the word signifies) in whom thou art safe, and
easy, and at rest, as a man is in his own house. Every true Israelite is
at home in God: the soul returns to him, and reposes in him. And they
that make him their habitation shall have all the comforts and benefits
of an habitation in him. And underneath are the everlasting arms - The
almighty power of God, which protects and comforts all that trust in
him, in their greatest straits and distresses. He shall thrust out the
enemy from before thee - Shall make room for thee by his resistless
power, and shall say, Destroy them - Giving thee not only a commission
but strength to put it in execution. And, has he not given the same
commission and the same strength to believers, to destroy all sin?</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p31">28. Alone - Either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p32">1. Tho' they be alone, and have no
confederates to defend them, but have all the world against them, yet my
single protection shall be sufficient for them. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p33">2. Distinct and separated from all other
nations, with whom I will not have them mingle themselves. The fountain
- That is, the posterity of Jacob, which flowed from him as waters from
a fountain, in great abundance. The fountain is here put for the river
or streams which flow from it, as Jacob or Israel who is the fountain is
often put for the children of Israel. His heavens - That is, those
heavens or that air which hangs over his land.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii-p34">29. The shield of they help - By whom thou are
sufficiently guarded against all assailants; and the sword of thy
excellency - Or, thy most excellent sword, that is, thy strength and the
author of all thy past or approaching victories. Those in whose hearts
is the excellency of holiness, have God himself for their shield and
sword. They are defended by the whole armour of God: His word is their
sword, and faith their shield. And thine enemies shall be found liars
unto thee - Who said they would destroy thee: or at least, that they
would never submit: and thou shalt tread upon their high places - Their
strong holds, palaces and temples. Thus shall the God of peace tread
Satan under the feet of all believers, and that shortly.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIV" progress="52.09%" prev="ii.vi.xxxiii.ii" next="ii.vi.xxxiv.i" id="ii.vi.xxxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Deut. XXXIV" id="ii.vi.xxxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Deut|34|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.34" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vi.xxxiv-p0.2">XXXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXIV" progress="52.09%" prev="ii.vi.xxxiv" next="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii" id="ii.vi.xxxiv.i">

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.i-p1">Moses having finished his testimony, finishes his life.
This chapter was probably added by Samuel, who wrote by divine authority
what he found in the records of Joshua, and his successors the Judges.
Here is, The view Moses had of the land, ver. 1-4. His death, burial,
and age, ver. 5-7. Israel's mourning for him, ver. 8. His successor,
ver. 9. His character, ver. 10-12.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXIV" progress="52.10%" prev="ii.vi.xxxiv.i" next="ii.vii" id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p1">1. And Moses went up - When he knew the place of his
death he cheerfully mounted a steep hill to come to it. Those who are
well acquainted with another world, are not afraid to leave this. When
God's servants are sent for out of the world, the summons runs go up and
die! Unto Daniel - To that city which after Moses's death was called
so.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p2">2. All Naphtali - The land of Naphtali, which together
with Daniel, was in the north of Canaan, as Ephraim and Manasseh were in
the midland parts, and Judah on the south, and the sea, on the west. So
these parts lying in the several quarters are put for all the rest. He
stood in the east and saw also Gilead, which was in the eastern part of
the land, and thence he saw the north and south and west. The utmost sea
- The midland sea, which was the utmost bound of the land of promise on
the west.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p3">3. The south - The south quarter of the land of Judah,
which is towards the salt sea, the city of palm-trees - Jericho, so
called from the multitude of palm-trees, which were in those parts, as
Josephus and Strabo write. From whence and the balm there growing it was
called Jericho, which signifies, odouriferous or sweet smelling.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p4">4. I have caused thee to see it - For tho' his sight was
good, yet he could not have seen all Canaan, an hundred and sixty miles
in length, and fifty or sixty in breadth, if his sight had not been
miraculously assisted and enlarged. He saw it at a distance. Such a
sight the Old Testament believers had of the kingdom of the Messiah. And
such a sight believers have now of the glory that shall he revealed.
Such a sight have we now, of the knowledge of the glory of the Lord,
which shall cover the earth. Those that come after us shall undoubtedly
enter into that promised land: which is a comfort to us, when we find
our own carcases falling in this wilderness.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p5">5. So Moses the servant of the Lord died - He is called
the servant of the Lord, not only as a good man, (all such are his
servants) but as a man eminently useful, who had served God's counsels
in bringing Israel out of Egypt, and leading them thro' the wilderness.
And it was more his honour, to be the servant of the Lord, than to be
king in Jeshurun. Yet he dies. Neither his piety nor his usefulness
would exempt him from the stroke of death. God's servants must die, that
they may rest from their labours, receive their recompense, and make
room for others. But when they go hence, they go to serve him better, to
serve him day and night in his temple. The Jews say, God sucked his soul
out of his body with a kiss. No doubt he died in the embraces of his
love.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p6">6. He - The Lord, buried him either immediately, or by
the ministry of angels, whereof Michael was the chief or prince. Of his
sepulchre - Of the particular place where he was buried: which God hid
from the Israelites, to prevent their superstition and idolatry, to
which he knew their great proneness. And for this very reason the devil
endeavoured to have it known and contended with Michael about it, <scripRef passage="Jude i. 9" id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Jude|1|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jude.1.9">Jude i, 9</scripRef>. God takes care even of the dead bodies of his servants. As
their death is precious, so is their dust. Not one grain of it shall be
lost, but the covenant with it shall be remembered.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p7">7. His eye was not dim - By a miraculous work of God in
mercy to his church and people.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p8">8. Thirty day's - Which was the usual time of mourning
for persons of high place and eminency. 'Tis a debt owing to the
surviving honour of deceased worthies, to follow them with our tears, as
those who loved and valued them, are sensible of the loss, and humbled
for the sins which have provoked God to deprive us of them.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p9">9. Wisdom - And other gifts and graces too, but wisdom is
mentioned as being most necessary for the government to which he was now
called. Upon him - And this was the thing which Moses at that time asked
of God for him.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p10">10. Whom the Lord - Whom God did so freely and familiarly
converse with.</p>

<p id="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii-p11">12. Moses was greater than any other of the prophets of
the Old Testament. By Moses God gave the law, and molded and formed the
Jewish church. By the other prophets he only sent particular reproofs,
directions and predictions. But as far as the other prophets came short
of him, our Lord Jesus went beyond him. Moses was faithful as a servant,
but Christ as a son: his miracles more illustrious, his communion with
the father more intimate: for he is in his bosom from eternity. Moses
lies buried: but Christ is sitting at the right-hand of God, and of the
increase of his government there shall be no end.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE BOOK OF JOSHUA" progress="52.18%" prev="ii.vi.xxxiv.ii" next="ii.vii.i" id="ii.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Josh" id="ii.vii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.vii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE BOOK OF JOSHUA</h2> 

<p id="ii.vii-p1">IN this book and those that follow to the end of Esther, we
have the history of the Jewish nation. These books, to the end of the
second book of Kings, the Jewish writers call, the first book of the
prophets: as being wrote by prophets, men divinely inspired. Indeed it
is probable they were collections of the authentic records of the
nation, which some of the prophets were divinely directed and assisted
to put together. It seems the substance of the several histories was
written under divine direction, when the events had just happened, and
long after put into the form wherein they stand now, perhaps all by the
same hand. In the five books of Moses we had a full account of the rise
and constitution of the Old Testament church, the miracles by which it
was built up, and the laws and ordinances by which it was to be
governed. And any nation that had statutes and judgments so righteous,
one would think, should have been very holy. But alas! a great part of
the history is a representation of their sins and miseries. For the law
made nothing perfect; that was to be done by the bringing in of the
better hope. The book of Joshua, if not written by him, was at least
collected out of his journals or memoirs. It contains the history of
Israel under the command of Joshua: how he presided over them,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.vii-p2">1. In their entrance into Canaan, chap.
i-v.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.vii-p3">2. In their conquest of Canaan, chap.
vi-xii.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.vii-p4">3. In the distribution of the land among the
tribes of Israel, chap. xiii-xxi.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.vii-p5">4. In the establishment of religion among them,
chap. 21-24. In all which he was a great example of wisdom, courage,
fidelity and piety. And in this history we may see,</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.vii-p6">1. Much of God and his providence; his power in
the kingdom of nature; his justice in punishing the Canaanites; his
faithfulness to his covenant with the patriarchs; his kindness to his
people:</p>

<p class="List2" id="ii.vii-p7">2. Much of Christ and his grace: Joshua being
in many respects an eminent type of him.</p>

<div3 title="I" progress="52.21%" prev="ii.vii" next="ii.vii.i.i" id="ii.vii.i">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua I" id="ii.vii.i-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.i-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="52.21%" prev="ii.vii.i" next="ii.vii.i.ii" id="ii.vii.i.i">

<p id="ii.vii.i.i-p1">In this chapter,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.vii.i.i-p2">1. God appoints Joshua to govern in the
stead of Moses, and gives him instructions and encouragement, ver.
1-9.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.vii.i.i-p3">2. He enters on his office immediately,
giving orders to the officers, and to the two tribes and an half, ver.
10-15.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.vii.i.i-p4">3. The people accept him as their governor,
ver. 16-18</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="52.22%" prev="ii.vii.i.i" next="ii.vii.ii" id="ii.vii.i.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p1">1. After the death of Moses - Either immediately after
it, or when the days of mourning for Moses were expired. Joshua was
appointed and declared Moses's successor in the government before this
time; and here he receives confirmation from God therein. The servant of
the Lord - This title is given to Moses here and ver. 2, as also <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxiv. 5" id="ii.vii.i.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Deut|34|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.34.5">Deut. xxxiv, 5</scripRef>, and is repeated not without cause, to reflect honour upon
him, to give authority to his laws and writings, in publishing whereof
he acted as God's servant, in his name: and that the Israelites might
not think of Moses above what was meet, remembering that he was not the
Lord himself, but only the Lord's servant; and therefore not to be too
pertinaciously followed in all his institutions when the Lord himself
should come and abolish part of the Mosaical dispensation; it being but
reasonable that he who was only a servant in God's house, should give
place to him who was the son, and heir, and Lord of it. The Lord spake -
Either in a dream or vision, or by Urim, <scripRef passage="Num. xxvii. 21" id="ii.vii.i.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Num|27|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.27.21">Num. xxvii, 21</scripRef>. Moses's minister - Who had waited upon Moses in his great
employments, and thereby been privy to his manner of government, and so
prepared for it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p2">2. Now therefore arise - Let not the withering of the
most useful hands be the weakening of ours. When God has work to do, he
will either find or make instruments fit to carry it on. Moses the
servant is dead; but God the master is not: he lives forever. This
Jordan - Which is now near thee, which is the only obstacle in thy way
to Canaan. Which I give - That is, am now about to give thee actual
possession of it, as I formerly gave a right to it by promise.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p3">3. Every place - That is, within the following
bounds.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p4">4. This Lebanon - Emphatically, as being the most eminent
mountain in Syria, and the northern border of the land: or this which is
within thy view. Hittites - Of the Canaanites, who elsewhere are all
called Amorites; (<scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 16" id="ii.vii.i.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Gen|15|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.16">Gen. xv, 16</scripRef>) and here Hittites, the Hittites being the most considerable
and formidable of all. The greater - The midland sea, great in itself,
and especially compared with those lesser collections of waters, which
the Jews called seas. "But the Israelites never possessed all this
land." I answer:</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.i.ii-p5">1. That was from their own sloth and
cowardice, and disobedience to God, and breach of those conditions upon
which this promise was suspended:</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.i.ii-p6">2. Though their possessions extended not to
Euphrates, yet their dominion did, and all those lands were tributary to
them in David's and Solomon's time.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p7">5. With Moses - To assist him against all his enemies,
and in all the difficulties of governing this stiff-necked people, which
Joshua might justly fear no less than the Canaanites. Forsake thee - I
will not leave thee destitute either of inward support, or of outward
assistance.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p8">6. Be strong and of a good courage - Joshua, though a
person of great courage and resolution, whereof he had given sufficient
proof, yet needs these exhortations, partly because his work was great,
and difficult, and long, and in a great measure new; partly because he
had a very mean opinion of himself, especially if compared with Moses;
and remembering how perverse and ungovernable that people were, even
under Moses, he might very well suspect the burden of ruling them would
be too heavy for his shoulders.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p9">7. Commanded thee - Remember, that though thou art the
commander of my people, yet thou art my subject, and obliged to observe
all my commands. To the right hand or to the left - That is, in any
kind, or upon any pretense; which plainly shews, that God's assistance
promised to him and the Israelites, was conditional, and might justly be
withdrawn upon their breach of the conditions. Whithersoever thou goest
- That is, whatsoever thou doest. Mens actions are often compared to
ways, or steps by which they come to the end they aim at.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p10">8. Out of thy mouth - That is, thou shalt constantly read
it, and upon occasion discourse of it, and the sentence which shall come
out of thy mouth, shall in all things be given according to this rule.
Day and night - That is, diligently study, and upon all occasions
consider what is God's will and thy duty. The greatness of thy place and
employments shall not hinder thee from this work, because this is the
only rule of all thy private actions, and publick administrations.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p11">9. I commanded thee - I whom thou art obliged to obey: I
who can carry thee through every thing I put thee upon: I of whose
faithfulness and almighty power thou hast had large experience?</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p12">10. The officers of the people - These who commanded
under Joshua, in their respective tribes and families, attended him for
orders, which they were to transmit to the people.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p13">11. Prepare you victuals - For although Manna was given
them to supply their want of ordinary provisions in the wilderness; yet
they were allowed, when they had opportunity, to purchase other
provisions, and did so, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 6, 28" id="ii.vii.i.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Deut|2|6|0|0;|Deut|2|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.6 Bible:Deut.2.28">Deut. ii, 6, 28</scripRef>. And now having been some time in the land of the Amorites,
and together with Manna used themselves to other food, which that
country plentifully supplied them with; they are warned to furnish
themselves therewith for their approaching march. Three days - These
words, though placed here, seem not to have been delivered by Joshua
'till after the return of the spies; such transpositions being frequent
in scripture. And hence it comes, that these three days mentioned here
below, after the history of the spies, are again repeated chap. iii,
2.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p14">13. Commanded you - His charge to you, and your promise
to him. Rest - That is, a place of rest, as that word signifies.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p15">14. Before their brethren -- in the front of all of them;
which was but reasonable; because they had the advantage of their
brethren, having actually received their portion, which their brethren
had only in hope, because they were freed from those impediments which
the rest were exposed to, their wives, and children, and estates being
safely lodged; and to prevent their withdrawing themselves from the
present service, which they otherwise would have had temptation to do,
because of the nearness of their habitations. Armed - For by this time
they were well furnished with arms, which they had either from the
Egyptians, Amalekites, or Amorites, from whom they had taken them; or by
purchase from those people by whose borders they passed. Men of valour -
All such were obliged to go over if occasion required it, but Joshua
took only some of them, because they were sufficient for his purpose,
and because some were fit to be left, both to secure their own wives,
children, and possessions, and to prevent their enemies on that side
from giving them disturbance in their enterprise upon Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p16">16. And they answered - Not the two tribes and an half
only, but the officers of all the people, in their name, concurring with
the divine appointment, by which Joshua was set over them. Thus must we
swear allegiance to our Lord Jesus, as the captain of our salvation.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.i.ii-p17">17. Unto thee - The same obedience which we owed, to
Moses, we promise unto thee. With Moses - This is not a limitation of
their obedience, as if they would not obey him any longer than he was
prosperous, but an additional prayer for him. As we have hereby promised
thee our obedience, so our prayer shall be, that God would bless and
prosper thee, as he did Moses.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="52.35%" prev="ii.vii.i.ii" next="ii.vii.ii.i" id="ii.vii.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua II" id="ii.vii.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.ii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="52.35%" prev="ii.vii.ii" next="ii.vii.ii.ii" id="ii.vii.ii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.ii.i-p1">Joshua sends spies to Jericho, ver. 1. Rahab receives and
conceals them, ver. 2-7. Her agreement with them for the safety of
herself and family, ver. 8-21. The return of the spies, and the account
given by them, ver. 22-24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="52.35%" prev="ii.vii.ii.i" next="ii.vii.iii" id="ii.vii.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p1">1. Sent - Or, had sent. Two men - Not twelve, as Moses
did, because those were to view the whole land, these but a small parcel
of it. To spy - That is, to learn the state of the land and people. It
is evident Joshua did not this out of distrust; it is probable, he had
God's command and direction in it for the encouragement of himself and
his army. Secretly - With reference not to his enemies, that being the
practice of all spies, but to the Israelites; a good caution to prevent
the inconveniency which possibly might have arisen, if their report had
been discouraging. Jericho - That is, the land about Jericho, together
with the city. Hebrew. The land and Jericho, that is, especially
Jericho. Harlot's - So the Hebrew word is used, <scripRef passage="Judg. xi. 1" id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Judg|11|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.11.1">Judg. xi, 1</scripRef>, and so it is rendered by two apostles, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 31" id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Heb|11|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.31">Heb. xi, 31</scripRef> <scripRef passage="James ii. 25" id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p1.3" parsed="|Jas|2|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.2.25">James ii, 25</scripRef>, such she either now was, or rather, had been formerly.
Lodged - Or, lay down; as the same word is rendered, ver. 8, composed
themselves to rest; but they were hindered from that intention.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p2">2. To night - This evening.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p3">3. Probably Israel had but one friend in all Jericho: and
God directed them to her! Thus what seems to be most accidental, is
often over-ruled, to serve the great ends of providence. And those that
acknowledge God in their ways, he will guide them with his eye.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p4">4. And the woman - Or, But the woman had taken - and had
hid them, before the messengers came from the king; as soon as she
understood from her neighbours, that there was a suspicion of the
matter, and guessed that search would be made. And this is justly
mentioned as a great and generous act of faith, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 31" id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Heb|11|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.31">Heb. xi, 31</scripRef>, for she apparently ventured her life upon a steadfast
persuasion of the truth of God's word and promise given to the
Israelites. Whence they were - Her answer contained in these and the
following words, was false, and therefore unquestionably sinful; tho'
her intention was good therein. But it is very probable, she being an
Heathen, might think, that an officious lie is not unlawful.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p5">6. Roof - Which was flat after their manner. Upon the
roof - That they might be dried by the heat of the sun.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p6">7. Fords - Or passages, that is, the places where people
used to pass over Jordan, whether by boats or bridges. The gate - Of the
city, to prevent the escape of the spies, if peradventure Rahab was
mistaken, and they yet lurked therein.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p7">8. Laid down - To sleep as they intended.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p8">9. Your terror - That is, the dread of you.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p9">11. Melted - That is, were dissolved, lost all
courage.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p10">12. By the Lord - By your God who is the only true God:
so she owns his worship, one eminent act whereof is swearing by his
name. My father's house - My near kindred, which she particularly names,
ver. 13, husband and children it seems she had none. And for herself, it
was needless to speak, it being a plain and undeniable duty to save
their preserver. True token - Either an assurance that you will preserve
me and mine from the common ruin: or a token which I may produce as a
witness of this agreement, and a means of my security. This is all that
she asks. But God did for her more than she could ask or think. She was
afterwards advanced to be a princess in Israel, the wife of Salmon and
one of the ancestors of Christ.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p11">13. All that they have - That is, their children, as
appears from chap. vi, 23.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p12">14. For yours - We will venture our lives for the
security of yours. Our business - That is, this agreement of ours, and
the condition of it, lest others under this pretense, should secure
themselves. By which they shew both their piety and prudence in managing
their oath with so much circumspection, that neither their own
consciences might be ensnared, nor the publick justice obstructed.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p13">15. Town-wall - Which gave her the opportunity of
dismissing them when the gates were shut. Upon the wall - Her particular
dwelling was there: which may possibly be added, because the other part
of her house was reserved for the entertainment of strangers.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p14">16. The mountain - That is, to some of the mountains
wherewith Jericho was encompassed, in which also there were many caves
where they might lurk. Three days - Not three whole days, but one whole
day, and part of two days.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p15">17. Said - Or, had said; namely, before she let them
down; it being very improbable, either that she would dismiss them
before the condition was agreed on; or that she would discourse with
them, or they with her, about such secret and weighty things after they
were let down, when others might overhear them. Blameless - That is,
free from guilt or reproach if it be violated, namely, if the following
condition be not observed.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p16">18. Into the land - That is, over Jordan, and near the
city. This line of scarlet - Probably the same with which she was about
to let them down. Window - That it may be easily discerned by our
soldiers.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p17">19. Upon his head - The blame of his death shall rest
wholly upon himself, as being occasioned by his own neglect of the means
of safety. Our head - We are willing to bear the sin, and shame, and
punishment of it. Be upon him - So as to kill him.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p18">21. In the window - Forthwith, partly that the spies
might see it hung out before their departure, and so the better know it
at some distance; partly lest some accident might occasion a neglect
about it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p19">22. Three days - Supporting themselves there with the
provisions, which Rahab had furnished them with. The ways - That is, in
the road to Jordan, and the places near it, but not in the
mountains.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ii.ii-p20">23. Passed over - Jordan unto Joshua.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="52.45%" prev="ii.vii.ii.ii" next="ii.vii.iii.i" id="ii.vii.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua III" id="ii.vii.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.iii-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="52.45%" prev="ii.vii.iii" next="ii.vii.iii.ii" id="ii.vii.iii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.iii.i-p1">The people decamp from Shittim, and are directed to
follow the ark, and sanctify themselves, ver. 1-5. The priests are
ordered to go first, ver. 6. Joshua being encouraged and directed as
God, tells the people what God is about to do, ver. 7 - 13. Jordan is
divided, and Israel marches through, ver. 14-17</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="52.45%" prev="ii.vii.iii.i" next="ii.vii.iv" id="ii.vii.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p1">1. In the morning - Not after the return of the spies,
but after the three days, chap. i, 11, as it follows, ver. iii, 2. Lodge
there - That night, that they might go over in the day time, that the
miracle might be more evident and unquestionable, and strike the greater
terror into their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p2">2. After three days - Either at the end of them, or upon
the last of them. Through the host - The second time to give them more
particular directions, as they had given them a general notice, chap. i,
10, 11.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p3">3. Commanded the people - In Joshua's name, and by his
authority. Priests and Levites - Who were not only Levites, but priests
also. For altho' the Levites were to carry the ark, <scripRef passage="Num. iv. 1-15" id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Num|4|1|4|15" osisRef="Bible:Num.4.1-Num.4.15">Num. iv, 1-15</scripRef>, yet the priests might perform that office, and did so upon
some solemn occasions. Go after it - Towards Jordan, to go over it in
such a manner as I am about to describe. 'Till this time the ark went in
the middle of the cloudy pillar, now it goes in the front. Probably the
pillar of fire and cloud was still hovering over the ark.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p4">4. Two thousand cubits - A thousand yards, at which
distance from it the Israelites seem to have been encamped in the
wilderness. And because they generally went from their tents to the ark
to worship God, especially on the sabbath-days; hence it hath been
conceived, that a sabbath-day's journey reached only to two thousand
cubits. But that may be doubted; for those who encamped nearest the ark,
were at that distance from it, and came so far; but the rest were
farther from it, and their sabbath-day's journey was considerably
longer. Near unto it - Partly from the respect they should bear to the
ark; but chiefly, that the ark marching so far before you into the
river, and standing still there 'till you pass over, may give you the
greater assurance of your safe passage. Ye have not passed this way
heretofore - While we are here, we must expect unusual events, to
pathways that we have not passed before: and much more when we go hence,
when we pass thro' the valley of the shadow of death. But if we have the
assurance of God's presence, what have we to fear?</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p5">5. And Joshua said - Or rather, had said, the day before
their passage; for it follows, tomorrow. Sanctify yourselves - Both in
soul and body, that you may be meet to receive such a favour, and with
more reverence observe this great work, and fix it in your hearts.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p6">6. Take up - Namely, upon your shoulders; for so they
were to carry it, <scripRef passage="Num. vii. 9" id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Num|7|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.7.9">Num. vii, 9</scripRef>. Before the people - Not in the middle of them, as you used
to do.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p7">7. Magnify thee - That is, to gain thee authority among
them, as the person whom I have set in Moses's stead, and by whom I will
conduct them to the possession of the promised land.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p8">8. The brink - Hebrew. to the extremity, so far as the
river then spread itself, which was now more than ordinary, ver. 15. In
Jordan - Within the waters of Jordan, in the first entrance into the
river; Where they stood for a season, 'till the river was divided, and
then they went into the midst of it, and there abode 'till all the
people were passed over. 9. Come hither - To the ark or tabernacle, the
place of public assemblies. The Lord your God - Who is now about to give
a proof that he is both the Lord, the omnipotent governor of heaven and
earth, and all creatures; and your God, in covenant with you, having a
tender care and affection for you.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p9">10. Ye shall know - By experience and sensible evidence.
The living God - Not a dull, dead, senseless God, such as the gods of
the nations are; but a God of life, and power, and activity to watch
over you, and work for you. Among you - Is present with you to
strengthen and help you.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p10">12. Twelve men - For the work described, chap. iv, 2,
3.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p11">13. The ark of the Lord - That so it may appear this is
the Lord's doing, and that in pursuance of his covenant made with
Israel. Of all the earth - The Lord of all this globe of earth and
water, who therefore can dispose of this river and the adjoining land as
he pleaseth. Cut off - The waters which now are united now shall be
divided, and part shall flow down the channel towards the dead sea, and
the other part that is nearer the spring of the river, and flows down
from it, shall stand still. An heap - Being as it were congealed, as the
Red-Sea was, <scripRef passage="Exod. xv. 8" id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Exod|15|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.15.8">Exod. xv, 8</scripRef>, and so kept from overflowing the country.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p12">15. All the time of harvest - This is meant not of
wheat-harvest, but of the barley-harvest, as is manifest from their
keeping the passover at their first entrance, chap. v, 10, which was
kept on the fourteenth day of the first month, when they were to bring a
sheaf of their first-fruits, which were of barley. So that this harvest
in those hot countries fell very early in the spring, when rivers used
to swell most; partly because of the rains which have fallen all the
winter, partly because of the snows which melt and come into the rivers.
And this time God chose that the miracle might be more glorious, more
amazing and terrible to the Canaanites; and that the Israelites might be
entertained at their first entrance with plentiful and comfortable
provisions.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p13">16. Adam - The city Adam being more obscure, is described
by its nearness to a more known place, then eminent, but now unknown.
The meaning is, that the waters were stopped in their course at that
place, and so kept at a distance from the Israelites whilst they passed
over. Against Jericho - Here God carried them over, because this part
was,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p14">1. The strongest, as having in its
neighbourhood an eminent city, a potent king, and a stout and war-like
people.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p15">2. The most pleasant and fruitful, and
therefore more convenient both for the refreshment of the Israelites
after their long and tedious marches, and for their encouragement.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iii.ii-p16">17. Stood firm - That is, in one and the same place and
posture; their feet neither moved by any waters moving in upon them, nor
sinking into any mire, which one might think was at the bottom of the
river. And this may be opposed to their standing on the bank of the
water when they came to it, commanded, ver. 8, which was but for a
while, 'till the waters were divided and gone away; and then they were
to go farther, even into the midst of Jordan, where they are to stand
constantly and fixedly, as this Hebrew word signifies, until all were
passed over. The midst of Jordan - In the middle and deepest part of the
river.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="52.57%" prev="ii.vii.iii.ii" next="ii.vii.iv.i" id="ii.vii.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua IV" id="ii.vii.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.iv-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="52.57%" prev="ii.vii.iv" next="ii.vii.iv.ii" id="ii.vii.iv.i">

<p id="ii.vii.iv.i-p1">Twelve stones taken up out of the midst of Jordan, and
twelve set up there for a memorial, ver. 1-9. The march of the people
through Jordan, ver. 10-13. God magnifies Joshua, who commands the
priests to come out of Jordan, ver. 14-17. The waters close again, ver.
18, 19. Joshua erects twelve stones for a memorial, ver. 20-24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="52.57%" prev="ii.vii.iv.i" next="ii.vii.v" id="ii.vii.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p1">1. Spake - This was commanded before, chap. iii, 12, and
is here repeated with enlargement, as being now to be put in
execution.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p2">2. Out of every tribe a man - For the greater evidence,
and the more effectual spreading the report of this marvelous work among
all the tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p3">3. Lodge this night - That is, in Gilgal, as is expressed
below, ver. 19, 20.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p4">4. Prepared - That is, appointed for that work, and
commanded to be ready for it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p5">5. Before the ark - That is, go back again to the place
where the ark stands.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p6">6. A sign - A monument or memorial of this day's
work.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p7">9. Twelve stones - These stones are not the same with
those which a man could carry upon his shoulder, ver. 5. They might be
very much larger; and being set up in two rows one above another, might
be seen, at least when the water was low, especially where it was
shallow, as it was ordinarily, though not at this time, when Jordan
overflowed all its banks. Add to this, that the waters of Jordan are
very clear; therefore these stones might be seen in it, either by those
who stood upon the shore, because the river was not broad; or by those
that passed in boats. Unto this day - This might be written, either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p8">1. by Joshua who probably wrote this book
near 20 years after this was done: or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p9">2. by some other holy man divinely
inspired, who inserted this and some such passages both in this book and
in the writings of Moses.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p10">10. Commanded Joshua - Not particularly, but in general;
because he commanded Joshua to observe and do all that God had commanded
him by Moses, and all that he should command him any other way. Hasted -
That is, passed over with haste, an argument of their fear, or weakness
of their faith; as on the contrary, the priests are commended that they
stood firm, and settled in their minds, as well as in the posture of
their bodies.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p11">13. Before the Lord - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p12">1. before the ark, or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p13">2. in the presence of God who observed
whether they would keep their covenant made with their brethren, or
not.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p14">16. Out of Jordan - For being now in the middle, and
deepest place of the river, they are most properly said to go up to the
land.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p15">17. The priests - Who stayed contentedly in the river,
'till God by Joshua called them out.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p16">18. Their place - Returned into their proper channel,
according to their natural and usual course.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p17">19. The first month - Namely, of Nisan, which wanted but
five days of forty years from the time of their coming out of Egypt,
which was on the fifteenth day of this month. So punctual is God in the
performing of his word, whether promised or threatened. And this day was
very seasonable for the taking up of the lambs which were to be used
four days after, according to the law, <scripRef passage="Exod. xii. 3, 6" id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Exod|12|3|0|0;|Exod|12|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12.3 Bible:Exod.12.6">Exod. xii, 3, 6</scripRef>. Gilgal - A place afterwards so called, chap. v, 9.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p18">20. In Gilgal - Probably in order, like so many little
pillars, to keep up the remembrance of this miraculous benefit.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.iv.ii-p19">23. Before us - That is, myself and Caleb, and all of us
here present; for this benefit, though done to their fathers, is justly
said to be done to themselves, because they were then in their parent's
loins. It greatly magnifies later mercies, to compare them with former
mercies; for hereby it appears, that God is the same yesterday, today
and forever.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="52.63%" prev="ii.vii.iv.ii" next="ii.vii.v.i" id="ii.vii.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua V" id="ii.vii.v-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.v-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="52.63%" prev="ii.vii.v" next="ii.vii.v.ii" id="ii.vii.v.i">

<p id="ii.vii.v.i-p1">The Canaanites terrified, ver. 1. Circumcision renewed,
ver. 2- 9. The passover kept, ver. 10. The Israelites eat corn, and the
manna ceases, ver. 11-12. Christ appears to Joshua, ver. 13-15.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="52.63%" prev="ii.vii.v.i" next="ii.vii.vi" id="ii.vii.v.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p1">1. Amorites - These and the Canaanites are mentioned for
all the rest, as being the chief of them for number, and power, and
courage. Westward - This is added to distinguish them from the other
Amorites, eastward from Jordan, whom Moses had subdued. Canaanites - So
the proper place of this nation was on both sides of Jordan. The sea -
The midland sea, all along the coast of it, which was the chief seat of
that people, though divers colonies of them were come into, and settled
in other places. Jordan - Which was their bulwark on the east-side,
where the Israelites were; for it is very probable they had taken away
all bridges near those parts; and the Israelites having been so long in
that neighbouring country, and yet not making any attempt upon them,
they were grown secure; especially now, when Jordan swelled beyond its
ordinary bounds; and therefore they did not endeavour to hinder their
passage. Melted - They lost all their courage, and durst attempt nothing
upon the Israelites; not without God's special providence, that the
Israelites might quietly participate of the two great sacraments of
their church, circumcision and the passover, and thereby be prepared for
their high and hard work, and for the possession of the holy and
promised land; which would have been defiled by an uncircumcised
people.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p2">2. At that time - As soon as ever they were come to
Gilgal, which was on the tenth day; and so this might be executed the
eleventh day, and that in the morning: on the thirteenth day they were
sore of their wounds, and on the fourteenth day they recovered, and at
the even of that day kept the passover. Make - Or, prepare, or make
ready, as this word sometimes used. As it was not necessary for those
who had such knives already to make others for that use; so it is not
probable that such were commanded to do so, but only to make them sharp
and fit for that work. The second time - He calleth this a second
circumcision, not as if these same persons had been circumcised before,
but with respect to the body of the people, where of one part had been
circumcised before, and the other at this time, which is called a second
time, in relation to some former time wherein they were circumcised,
either, in Egypt, when many of the people, who possibly for fear or
favour of the Egyptians, had neglected this duty, were by the command of
Moses circumcised. Or at Sinai, when they received the passover, <scripRef passage="Num. ix. 5" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Num|9|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.9.5">Num. ix, 5</scripRef>, which no uncircumcised person might do.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p3">3. And circumcised - That is, he caused this to be done;
and, because it was to be done speedily, the passover approaching, it
was necessary to use many hands in it. Children of Israel - That is,
such of them as were uncircumcised. And, though it be not mentioned, it
is more than probable, that the Israelites beyond Jordan were
circumcised at the same time.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p4">4. Out of Egypt - This is to be restrained to such as
were then above twenty years old, and such as were guilty of that
rebellion, <scripRef passage="Num. xiv. 1-25" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Num|14|1|14|25" osisRef="Bible:Num.14.1-Num.14.25">Num. xiv, 1-25</scripRef>, as it is expressed below, ver. 6.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p5">5. Them - Either their parents, or the rulers of Israel,
by Divine permission and indulgence; because they were now on a journey,
in which case the passover also might be neglected, <scripRef passage="Num. ix. 10, 13" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Num|9|10|0|0;|Num|9|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.9.10 Bible:Num.9.13">Num. ix, 10, 13</scripRef>. Rather, it was a continued token of God's displeasure
against them, for their unbelief and murmuring: a token that they should
never have the benefit of that promise, whereof circumcision was the
seal.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p6">6. The people - The Hebrew word commonly signifies the
Gentiles; so he calls them, to note that they were unworthy the name of
Israelites. Shew them - That is, not give them so much as a sight of it,
which he granted to Moses, much less the possession.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p7">7. Circumcised - Which God would have done,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p8">1. As a testimony of God's reconciliation
to the people, and that he would not farther impute their parents
rebellion to them.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p9">2. Because the great impediment of
circumcision was now removed, their continued travels, and frequent and
uncertain removal.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p10">3. To prepare them for the approaching
passover.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p11">4. To distinguish them from the Canaanites,
into whose land they were now come.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p12">5. To ratify the covenant between God and
them, whereof circumcision was a sign and seal, to assure them that God
would now make good his covenant, in giving them this land; and to
oblige them to perform all the duties to which that covenant bound them,
as soon as they came into Canaan, <scripRef passage="Exod. xii. 25" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Exod|12|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12.25">Exod. xii, 25</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Lev. xxiii. 10" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p12.2" parsed="|Lev|23|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.23.10">Lev. xxiii, 10</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Num. xv. 2" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p12.3" parsed="|Num|15|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.15.2">Num. xv, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p13">8. Whole - Free from that pain and soreness which
circumcision caused, it was indeed an act of great faith, to expose
themselves to so much pain and danger too, in this place where they were
hemmed in by Jordan and their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p14">9. The reproach of Egypt - That is, uncircumcision, was
both in truth, and in the opinion of the Jews, a matter of great
reproach, and although this was a reproach common to most nations of the
world, yet it is particularly called the reproach of Egypt, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p15">1. because the other neighbouring nations,
being the children of Abraham by the concubines, are supposed to have
been circumcised, which the Egyptians at this time were not, as may be
gathered from <scripRef passage="Exod. ii. 6" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Exod|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.2.6">Exod. ii, 6</scripRef>, where they knew the child to be an Hebrew by this mark.
Or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p16">2. because they came out of Egypt, and were
esteemed to be a sort of Egyptians, <scripRef passage="Num. xxii. 5" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Num|22|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.22.5">Num. xxii, 5</scripRef>, which they justly thought a great reproach; but by their
circumcision they were now distinguished from them, and manifested to be
another people. Or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p17">3. because many of them lay under this
reproach in Egypt, having wickedly neglected this duty there for worldly
reasons; and others of them continued in the same shameful condition for
many years in the wilderness. Gilgal - That is, rolling.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p18">10. The passover - Which was their third passover: the
first was in Egypt, <scripRef passage="Exod. xii. 11-24" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Exod|12|11|12|24" osisRef="Bible:Exod.12.11-Exod.12.24">Exod. xii, 11-24</scripRef>, the second at Mount Sinai, <scripRef passage="Num. ix. 1-5" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p18.2" parsed="|Num|9|1|9|5" osisRef="Bible:Num.9.1-Num.9.5">Num. ix, 1-5</scripRef>, the third here; for in their wilderness travels, these and
all other sacrifices were neglected, <scripRef passage="Amos v. 25" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p18.3" parsed="|Amos|5|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Amos.5.25">Amos v, 25</scripRef>. While they were in the wilderness, they were denied the
comfort of this ordinance, as a farther token of God's displeasure. But
now God comforted them again, after the time that he had afflicted
them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p19">11. Old corn - The corn of the last year, which the
inhabitants of those parts had left in their barns, being fled into
their strong cities, or other remoter parts. The morrow - That is, on
the sixteenth day; for the passover was killed between the two evenings
of the fourteenth day, and was eaten in that evening or night, which,
according to the Jewish computation, whereby they begin their days at
the evening, was a part of the fifteenth day, all which was the feast of
the passover; and so the morrow of the sixteenth day, was the morrow
after the passover, when they were obliged to offer unto God the first
sheaf, and then were allowed to eat of the rest. Parched corn - Of that
year's corn. which was most proper for that use. Self-same day - Having
an eager desire to enjoy the fruits of the land. And this corn came very
seasonably; for after the passover, they were to keep the feast of
unleavened bread, which they could not do, when they had nothing but
manna to live upon.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p20">12. The manna ceased - Which God now withheld, to shew
that Manna was not an ordinary production of nature, but an
extraordinary and special gift of God to supply their necessity. And
because God would not be prodigal of his favours, by working miracles
where ordinary means were sufficient. The morrow - That is, on the
seventeenth day.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p21">13. By Jericho - Hebrew. In Jericho, that is, in the
territory adjoining to it; whither he went to view those parts, and
discern the fittest places for his attempt upon Jericho. A man - One in
the appearance of a man. Drawn - In readiness to fight, not, as Joshua
thought, against him, but for him and his people.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p22">14. As captain - I am the chief captain of this people,
and will conduct and assist thee and them in this great undertaking. Now
this person is not a created angel, but the son of God, who went along
with the Israelites in this expedition, as their chief and captain. And
this appears,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p23">1. By his acceptance of adoration here,
which a created angel durst not admit of, <scripRef passage="Rev. xxii. 8, 9" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p23.1" parsed="|Rev|22|8|22|9" osisRef="Bible:Rev.22.8-Rev.22.9">Rev. xxii, 8, 9.</scripRef></p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p24">2. Because the place was made holy by his
presence, ver. 15, which was God's prerogative, <scripRef passage="Exod. iii. 5" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p24.1" parsed="|Exod|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.3.5">Exod. iii, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.v.ii-p25">3. Because he is called the Lord, Hebrew.
Jehovah, chap. vi, 2. My Lord - I acknowledge thee for my Lord and
captain, and therefore wait for thy commands, which I am ready to
obey.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.v.ii-p26">15. From thy foot - In token of reverence and subjection.
Holy - Consecrated by my presence. The very same orders which God gave
to Moses at the bush, when he was sending him to bring Israel out of
Egypt, he here gives to Joshua, for the confirming his faith, that as he
had been with Moses, so he would be with him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="52.79%" prev="ii.vii.v.ii" next="ii.vii.vi.i" id="ii.vii.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua VI" id="ii.vii.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.vi-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="52.79%" prev="ii.vii.vi" next="ii.vii.vi.ii" id="ii.vii.vi.i">

<p id="ii.vii.vi.i-p1">Directions given to Joshua concerning Jericho, ver. 1-5.
The people compass the city seven days, ver. 6-14. The taking it, with
the charge to destroy it utterly, ver. 15-21. The preservation of Rahab
and her relations, ver. 22-25. A curse pronounced on any that should
rebuild it, ver. 26, 27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="52.79%" prev="ii.vii.vi.i" next="ii.vii.vii" id="ii.vii.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p1">3. Round about the city once - At a convenient distance,
out of the reach of their arrows. Six days - Every day once. This and
the following course might seem ridiculous and absurd, and is therefore
prescribed by God, that they might learn to take new measures of things,
and to expect success not from their own valour, or skill, but merely
from God's appointment and blessing; and in general, not to judge of any
of God's institutions by mere carnal reason, to which divers of their
ceremonies would seem no less foolish than this action.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p2">5. The wall - Not all of it; which was unnecessary, and
might have given the people better opportunity of escaping, but only a
considerable part of it, where the Israelites might fitly enter: for
Rahab's house was not overthrown, ver. 22. Flat - Hebrew. under it, it
was not battered down with engines which would have made part of it fall
out of its place; but it fell of its own accord, and therefore in the
place it did formerly stand in. God chose this way, to try the faith and
obedience of the people: whether they would observe a precept, which to
human policy seemed foolish, and believe a promise, which seemed
impossible to be performed: whether they could patiently bear the
reproaches of their enemies, and patiently wait for the salvation of
God. Thus by faith, not by force, the walls of Jericho fell down.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p3">6. Of rams horns - Of the basest matter, and the dullest
sound, that the excellency of the power might be of God.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p4">7. Him that is armed - God would have them armed both for
the defense of themselves and the ark, in case the enemies should make a
sally upon them, and for the execution of the Lord's vengeance upon that
city.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p5">9. The rereward - Which being opposed to the armed men,
may seem to note the unarmed people, who were desirous to be spectators
of this wonderful work.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p6">10. Ye shall not shout - Because shouting before the time
appointed, would be ineffectual, and so might give them some
discouragement, and their enemies matter of insulting.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p7">16. Shout - To testify your faith in God's promise, and
thankfulness for this glorious mercy; to encourage yourselves and
brethren, and to strike a terror into your enemies. Given you the city -
It is given to them, to be devoted to God, as the first, and perhaps the
worst of all the cities of Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p8">17. Accursed - That is, devoted to utter destruction.
This he speaks by direction from God, as is evident from <scripRef passage="1 Kings xvi. 34" id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|1Kgs|16|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.16.34">1 Kings xvi, 34</scripRef>. To the Lord - Partly because the first-fruits were
appropriated to God; partly lest the soldiers being glutted with the
spoil of the rich city, should grow sluggish in their work; and partly
to strike the greater terror into the rest of their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p9">18. A curse - By provoking God to punish them for your
sin, in which they may be one way or other involved; or the whole camp
having sins of their own, God might take what occasion he saw fit to
inflict this punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p10">19. Vessels of brass and iron - Except that of which
images were made, which were to be utterly destroyed. Unto the Lord -
Being first made to pass through the fire, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxi. 22, 23" id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Num|31|22|31|23" osisRef="Bible:Num.31.22-Num.31.23">Num. xxxi, 22, 23</scripRef>. Treasury of the Lord - To be employed wholly for the uses
of the tabernacle, not to be applied to the use of any private person or
priest.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p11">21. Young and old - Being commanded to do so by the
sovereign Lord of every man's life; and being informed by God before
that the Canaanites were abominably wicked, and deserved the severest
punishments. As for the infants, they were guilty of original sin, and
otherwise at the disposal of their creator; but if they had been wholly
innocent, it was a great favour to them to take them away in infancy,
rather than reserve them to those dreadful calamities which those who
survived them were liable to.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p12">22. Harlot's house - Which together with the wall upon
which it leaned, was left standing, by a special favour of God to
her.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p13">23. Without the camp of Israel - 'Till they were cleansed
from the impurities of their Gentile state, and instructed in the Jewish
religion, and solemnly admitted into that church, for which Rahab's good
counsel and example had doubtless prepared them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p14">25. The harlot olive - For that general command of
rooting out the Canaanites seems to have had some exception, in case any
of them had sincerely and seasonably cast off their wickedness, and
submitted to the Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p15">26. Adjured them - Or, made them to fear; caused the
people, or some in the name of all, to swear for the present and
succeeding generations, and to confirm their oath by a curse. Before the
Lord - That is, from God's presence, and by his sentence, as they are
said to cast lots before the Lord, chap. xviii, 8, 10, that is,
expecting the design from God. He intimates, that he doth not utter this
upon a particular dislike of that place, but by divine inspiration. God
would have the ruins of this city remain as a standing monument of God's
justice against this wicked and idolatrous people, and of his almighty
power in destroying so great and strong a city by such contemptible
means. Buildeth - That is, that shall attempt to build it. So this curse
is restrained to the builder, but no way belongs to those who should
inhabit it after it was built, as is evident from <scripRef passage="2 Kings iv. 18" id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p15.1" parsed="|2Kgs|4|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.4.18">2 Kings iv, 18</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Luke xix. 1, 5" id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p15.2" parsed="|Luke|19|1|0|0;|Luke|19|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.19.1 Bible:Luke.19.5">Luke xix, 1, 5</scripRef>. In his youngest son - That is, he shall lose all his
children in the work, the first at the beginning, others in the progress
of it by degrees, and the youngest in the close of it, when the gates
use to be set up. This was fulfilled, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xvi. 34" id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p15.3" parsed="|1Kgs|16|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.16.34">1 Kings xvi, 34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vi.ii-p16">27. The word of the Lord was with him - (So the Chaldee:)
Even Christ himself, the same that was with Moses. Nothing makes a man
appear more truly great, than to have the evidences of God's presence
with him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="52.89%" prev="ii.vii.vi.ii" next="ii.vii.vii.i" id="ii.vii.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua VII" id="ii.vii.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.vii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="52.89%" prev="ii.vii.vii" next="ii.vii.vii.ii" id="ii.vii.vii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.vii.i-p1">We have here the sin of Achan in taking the accursed
thing, ver. 1. The defeat of Israel before Ai, ver. 2-5. Joshua's
humiliation and prayer, ver. 6-9. God's directions to him, ver. 10- 15.
The discovery, conviction, and execution of the criminal, ver.
16-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="52.90%" prev="ii.vii.vii.i" next="ii.vii.viii" id="ii.vii.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p1">1. The children of Israel - That is, one of them, by a
very usual figure, as <scripRef passage="Matt. xxvi. 8" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|26|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.26.8">Matt. xxvi, 8</scripRef>, where that is ascribed to the disciples, which belonged to
Judas only, <scripRef passage="John xii. 4" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|John|12|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.12.4">John xii, 4</scripRef>. Accursed thing - That is, in taking some of the forbidden
and accursed goods. Zabdi - Called also Zimri, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ii. 6" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p1.3" parsed="|1Chr|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.2.6">1 Chron. ii, 6</scripRef>. Zerah - Or, Zarah, who was Judah's immediate son, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxviii. 30" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p1.4" parsed="|Gen|38|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.38.30">Gen. xxxviii, 30</scripRef>, who went with Judah into Egypt: and so for the filling up
the 256 years that are supposed to come between that and this time, we
must allow Achan to be, now an old man, and his three ancestors to have
begotten each his son at about sixty years of age; which at that time
was not incredible nor unusual. Against the children of Israel - Why did
God punish the whole society for this one man's sin? All of them were
punished for their own sins, whereof each had a sufficient proportion;
but God took this occasion to inflict the punishment upon the society,
partly because divers of them might be guilty of this sin, either by
coveting what he actually did, or by concealing his fault, which it is
probable could not be unknown to others; or by not sorrowing for it, and
endeavouring to purge themselves from it: partly to make sin the more
hateful; as being the cause of such dreadful judgments: and partly to
oblige all the members of every society to be more circumspect in
ordering their own actions, and more diligent to prevent the
miscarriages of their brethren, which is a great benefit to them, and to
the whole society.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p2">2. To Ai - They were not to go into the city of Ai, but
into the country belonging to it, to understand the state of the place;
and the people.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p3">3. Go up - Which was done by the wise contrivance of
Divine providence, that their sin might be punished, and they awaked and
reformed with as little mischief and reproach, as might be: for if the
defeat of these caused so great a consternation in Joshua, it is easy to
guess what dread it would have caused in the people if a host had been
defeated.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p4">4. They fled - Not having courage to strike a stroke,
which was a plain evidence that God had forsaken then; and an useful
instruction, to shew them what they were when God left them: and that it
was God, not their own valour, that gave the Canaanites into their
hands.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p5">5. About thirty and six men - A dear victory to them,
whereby Israel was awakened and reformed, and they hardened to their own
ruin. The going down - By which it seems it was a down-hill way to
Jericho, which was nearer Jordan. As water - Soft and weak, and full of
fluctuation and trembling.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p6">6. Rent his clothes - In testimony of great sorrow, for
the loss felt, the consequent mischief feared, and the sin which he
suspected. His face - In deep humiliation and fervent supplication.
Until the even-tide - Continuing the whole day in fasting and prayer.
Put dust upon their heads - As was usual in case of grief and
astonishment.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p7">7. Over Jordan - This and the following clause, tho' well
intended, yet favour of human infirmity, and fall short of that
reverence and modesty, and submission, which he owed to God; and are
mentioned as instances that the holy men of God were subject to like
passions and infirmities with other men.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p8">8. What shall I say - In answer to the reproaches of our
insulting enemies. When Israel - God's people, which he hath singled out
of all nations for his own.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p9">9. Thy great name - Which will upon this occasion be
blasphemed and charged with inconstancy, and with inability to resist
them, or to do thy people that good which thou didst intend them. The
name of God is a great name, above every name. And whatever happens, we
ought to pray, that this may not be polluted. This should be our concern
more than any thing else: on this we should fix our eye: and we cannot
urge a better plea than this, Lord, what wilt thou do for thy great
name? Let God in all be glorified, and then welcome his whole will!</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p10">10. Upon thy face - This business is not to be done by
inactive supplication, but by vigourous endeavours for reformation.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p11">11. Israel - Some or one of them. Transgressed my
covenant - That is, broken the conditions of my covenant which they have
promised to perform, whereof this was one, not to meddle with the
accursed thing. Stolen - That is, taken my portion which I had reserved,
chap. vi, 19. Dissembled - Covered the fact with deep dissimulation.
Possibly Achan might be suspected, and being accused, had denied it.
Among their own stuff - Converted it to their own use, and added
obstinacy to the crime.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p12">12. Were accursed - They have put themselves out of my
protection, and therefore are liable to the same destruction which
belongs to this accursed people.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p13">13. Sanctify yourselves - Purify yourselves from that
defilement which you have all in some sort contracted by this accursed
fact, and prepare yourselves to appear before the Lord, expecting the
sentence of God for the discovery and punishment of the sin, and that
the guilty person might hereby be awakened, and brought to a free
confession of his fault. And it is a marvelous thing that Achan did not
on this occasion acknowledge his crime; but this is to be imputed to the
heart-hardening power of sin, which makes men, grow worse and worse; to
his pride, being loath to take to himself the shame of such a
mischievous and infamous action; and to his vain conceit, whereby he
might think others were guilty as well as he, and some of them might be
taken, and he escape.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p14">14. The Lord taketh - Which shall be declared guilty by
the lot, which is disposed by the Lord, <scripRef passage="Prov. xvi. 33" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Prov|16|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.16.33">Prov. xvi, 33</scripRef>, and which was to be cast in the Lord's presence before the
ark. Of such use of lots, see <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xiv. 41, 42" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p14.2" parsed="|1Sam|14|41|14|42" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.14.41-1Sam.14.42">1 Sam. xiv, 41, 42</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Jonah i. 7" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p14.3" parsed="|Jonah|1|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jonah.1.7">Jonah i, 7</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Acts i. 26" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p14.4" parsed="|Acts|1|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.1.26">Acts i, 26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p15">15. Shall be burnt with fire - As persons and things
accursed were to be. All that he hath - His children and goods, as is
noted, ver. 24, according to the law, <scripRef passage="Deut. xiii. 16" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Deut|13|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.13.16">Deut. xiii, 16</scripRef>. Wrought folly - So sin is often called in scripture, in
opposition to the idle opinion of sinners, who commonly esteem it to be
their wisdom. In Israel - That is, among the church and people of God
who had such excellent laws to direct them, and such an all-sufficient
and gracious God to provide for them, without any such unworthy
practices. It was sacrilege, it was invading God's rights, and
converting to a private use that which was devoted to his glory, which
was to be thus severely punished, for a warning to all people in all
ages, to take heed how they rob God.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p16">17. The family - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p17">1. the tribe or people, as the word family
sometimes signifies, or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p18">2. the families, as ver. 14, the singular
number for the plural, the chief of each of their five families, <scripRef passage="Num. xxvi. 20, 21" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Num|26|20|26|21" osisRef="Bible:Num.26.20-Num.26.21">Num. xxvi, 20, 21</scripRef>. Man by man - Not every individual person, as is evident
from ver. 18, but every head of the several houses, or lesser families
of that greater family of the Zarhites, of which see <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ii. 6" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p18.2" parsed="|1Chr|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.2.6">1 Chron. ii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p19">19. My son - So he calls him, to shew, that this severe
inquisition and sentence did not proceed from any hatred to his person,
which he loved as a father doth his son, and as a prince ought to do
each of his subjects. The Lord God of Israel - As thou hast highly
dishonoured him, now take the blame to thyself, and ascribe unto God the
glory of his omniscience in knowing thy sin, of his justice in punishing
it in thee, and others for thy sake; of his omnipotency, which was
obstructed by thee; and of his kindness and faithfulness to his people,
which was eclipsed by thy wickedness; all which will now be evident by
thy sin confessed and punished.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p20">20. Indeed I have sinned - He seems to make a sincere and
ingenuous confession, and loads his sin with all just aggravations.
Against the Lord - Against his express command, and glorious attributes.
God of Israel - The true God, who hath chosen me and all Israel to be
the people of his peculiar love and care.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p21">21. When I saw - He accurately describes the progress of
his sin, which began at his eye, which he permitted to gaze upon them,
which inflamed his desire, and made him covet them; and that desire made
him take them; and having taken, resolve to keep them; and to that end
hide them in his tent. Babylonish garment - Which were composed with
great art with divers colours, and of great price, as appears both from
scripture, and Heathen authors. Two hundred shekels - To wit, in weight,
not in coin; for as yet they received and payed money by weight. The
silver under it - That is, under the Babylonish garment; covered with
it, or wrapt up in it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p22">22. Sent messengers - That the truth of his confession
might be unquestionable, which some, peradventure might think was forced
from him. And they ran - Partly longing to free themselves and all the
people from the curse under which they lay; and partly that none of
Achan's relations might get thither before them, and take away the
things. It was hid - That is, the parcel of things mentioned, ver. 21
and 24.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p23">23. Before the Lord - Where Joshua and the elders
continued yet in their assembly waiting for the issue.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p24">24. His sons, and his daughters - Their death was a debt
they owed to their own sins, which debt God may require when he
pleaseth; and he could not take it in more honourable circumstances than
these, that the death of a very few in the beginning of a new empire,
and of their settlement in the land, might be useful to prevent the
deaths of many thousands who took warning by this dreadful example,
whom, if the fear of God did not, yet the love of their own, and of
their dear children's lives would restrain from such pernicious
practices. And it is very probable they were conscious of the fact, as
the Jewish doctors affirm. If it be pretended that some of them were
infants; the text doth not say so, but only calls them sons and
daughters. And considering that Achan was an old man, as is most
probable, because he was the fifth person from Judah, it seems most
likely, that the children were grown up, and so capable of knowing, and
concealing, or discovering this fact. His oxen, and his asses, and his
sheep - Which, though not capable of sin, nor of punishment, properly so
called, yet as they were made for man's use, so they are rightly
destroyed for man's good; and being daily killed for our bodily food, it
cannot seem strange to kill them for the instruction of our minds, that
hereby we might learn the contagious nature of sin, which involves
innocent creatures in its plagues; and how much sorer punishments are
reserved for man, who having a law given to him, and that excellent gift
of reason and will to restrain him from the transgressions of it, his
guilt must needs be unspeakably greater, and therefore his sufferings
more severe and terrible. Farther, by this enumeration it appears, that
he had no colour of necessity to induce him to this fact.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p25">25. With stones - And burned him with fire; which is
easily understood both out of the following words, and from God's
command to do so. They were stoned (which was the punishment of such
offenders, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxiv. 14" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p25.1" parsed="|Lev|24|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.24.14">Lev. xxiv, 14</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Num. xv. 35" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p25.2" parsed="|Num|15|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.15.35">Num. xv, 35</scripRef>,) and not burned to death; but God would have their dead
carcases burned to shew his utmost detestation of such persons as break
forth into sins of such a public scandal and mischief.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p26">26. A great heap of stones - As a monument of the sin and
judgment here mentioned, that others might be warned by the example; and
as a brand of infamy, as chap. viii, 29; <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xviii. 17" id="ii.vii.vii.ii-p26.1" parsed="|2Sam|18|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.18.17">2 Sam. xviii, 17</scripRef>. The valley of Achor - Or, the valley of trouble, from the
double trouble expressed, ver. 25.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="53.10%" prev="ii.vii.vii.ii" next="ii.vii.viii.i" id="ii.vii.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua VIII" id="ii.vii.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.viii-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="53.10%" prev="ii.vii.viii" next="ii.vii.viii.ii" id="ii.vii.viii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.viii.i-p1">Here is God's encouragement to Joshua, ver. 1, 2.
Joshua's orders to the men of war, ver. 3-8. The stratagem succeeds,
ver. 9- 22. Joshua takes and destroys the city, ver. 23-29. The solemn
writing and reading of the law before all Israel, ver. 30-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="53.11%" prev="ii.vii.viii.i" next="ii.vii.ix" id="ii.vii.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p1">1. Take all the people - That all of them might be
partakers of this first spoil, and thereby encouraged to proceed in
their work. The weak multitude indeed were not to go, because they might
have hindered them in the following stratagem; and it was but fit that
the military men who run the greatest hazards, should have the
precedency in the spoils.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p2">2. To Ai - That is, the city and people of Ai. Unto
Jericho and her king - That is, overcome and destroy them. This was
enjoined to chastise their last insolence, and the triumphs and
blasphemies which doubtless their success had produced: and to revive
the dread and terror which had been impressed upon the Canaanites by
Jericho's ruin, and had been much abated by the late success of Ai.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p3">3. To go up against Ai - That is, to consider about this
expedition; not as if all the people of war did actually go up, which
was both unnecessary and burdensome: but it seems to be resolved by
Joshua and all the council of war, that the thirty thousand here
following should be selected for the enterprize. Either, 1, the thirty
thousand now mentioned; or, 2. part of them; namely, such as were to lie
in wait; and these were only five thousand men, as is expressed, ver.
12.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p4">4. Them - The same party last spoken of, even the five
thousand mentioned ver. 12, there are only two parties engaged in the
taking of Ai, and but one ambush, as plainly appears by comparing ver.
9, with ver. 12, which speaks only of five thousand, who are justly
supposed to be a part of those thirty thousand named, ver. 3.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p5">5. That are - Or, that shall be: for at present he sent
them away, ver. 9, but the next morning followed, and joined himself
with them, ver. 10, 11. That we - I and the twenty five thousand with
me.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p6">9. Sent them - The same party. Among the people - Hebrew.
that people, the people of war as they are called, ver. 11, that is, the
main body of the host consisting of thirty thousand.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p7">10. The people - Hebrew. that people, not all the people
of Israel; which was needless, and required more time than could now be
spared; but the rest of that host of thirty thousand, whereof five
thousand were sent away; the remainder are numbered, to see whether some
of them had not withdrawn themselves, taking the advantage of the night,
and of the design of laying an ambush; and that it might be evident,
this work was done without any loss of men, whereby they might be
encouraged to trust in God, and to proceed resolutely in their work. The
elders of Israel - The chief magistrates and rulers of Israel under
Joshua; and these, I suppose, went with Joshua, and with the army, to
take care that the cattle and the spoil of the city, which was given by
God to all Israel for a prey, ver. 2, 27, might be justly and equally
divided between those that went to battle, and the rest of the
people.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p8">11. That were with him - Namely, the thirty thousand
mentioned, ver. 3, or the most of them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p9">12. And he took - Or rather, but he had taken, namely,
out of the said number of thirty thousand, for this is added by way of
recapitulation and farther explication of what is said in general, ver.
9.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p10">13. Joshua went - Namely, accompanied with a small part
of the host now mentioned, that is, very early in the morning, when it
was yet dark, as is said in a like case, <scripRef passage="John xx. 1" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|John|20|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.20.1">John xx, 1</scripRef>, whence it is here called night, though it was early in the
morning, as is said, ver. 10, for it seems most probable, that all was
done in one night's space, and in this manner; Joshua sends away the
ambush by night, ver. 3, and lodgeth that night with twenty-five
thousand men, ver. 9, not far from the city. But not able or willing to
sleep all night, he rises very early, ver. 10, and numbers his men,
which by the help of the several officers was quietly done, and so
immediately leads them towards Ai; and while it was yet duskish or
night, he goes into the midst of the valley, ver. 13, and when the day
dawns he is discovered by the king and people of Ai, who thereupon rose
up early to fight with them, ver. 14. The valley - Which was near the
city, thereby to allure them forth.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p11">14. His people - Namely, all his men of war, for the rest
were left in Ai, ver. 16. At a time appointed - At a certain hour agreed
upon between the king and people of Ai, and of Bethel too, who were
their confederates in this enterprize, as it may seem from ver. 17.
Possibly they might appoint the same hour of the day on which they had
fought against Israel with good success, looking upon it as a lucky
hour. Before the plain - That is, towards or in sight of that plain or
valley in which the Israelites were, that so they might put themselves
in battle-array. Against him - The former success having made him
secure, as is usual in such cases; God also blinding his mind, and
infatuating him, as he useth to do with those whom he intends to
destroy.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p12">15. Made as if they were beaten - That is, fled from
them, as it were for fear of a second blow. The wilderness - Which lay
between Ai and Jericho, whither they now seemed to flee.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p13">16. All the people - Namely, all that were able to bear
arms, for old men and children were unfit for the pursuit or fight; and
that they were yet left, may seem from ver. 24, 25.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p14">17. Not a man - Namely, fit for war. Bethel - Which,
being a neighbouring city, and encouraged by the former success, had
sent some forces to assist them; and now, upon notice sent to them of
the flight of their common enemies, or upon some other signal given, all
their men of war join with those of Ai in the pursuit.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p15">18. Stretch out the spear - This was, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p16">1. for a sign to his host present with him,
to stop their flight, and make head against the pursuers: or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p17">2. for a signal to the liers in wait,
or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p18">3. as a token of God's presence and
assistance with them, and of their victory.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p19">19. Set the city on fire - Not all of it, as appears from
ver. 28, and because then they had lost that prey which God had allowed
them; but part of it, enough to raise a smoke, and give notice to their
brethren of their success.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p20">21. All Israel - That is, all the Israelites there
present.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p21">22. The other - They who lay in ambush.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p22">23. Took alive - Reserving him to a more ignominious
punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p23">24. Smote it - That is, the inhabitants of it, the men,
who through age or infirmity were unfit for war, and the women, ver.
25.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p24">25. Of Ai - Not strictly, but largely so called, who were
now in Ai, either as constant and settled inhabitants, or as sojourners
and such as came to them for their help.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p25">26. Drew not his hand back - He kept his hand and spear
in the same posture, both stretched out and lifted up, as a sign both to
encourage them, and to direct them to go on in the work.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p26">29. Hanged on a tree - He dealt more severely with the
kings of Canaan than with the people, because the abominable wickedness
of that people was not restrained and punished (as it should have been)
but countenanced and encouraged by their evil examples; and because they
were the principal authors of the destruction of their own people, by
engaging them in an obstinate opposition against the Israelites. Down
from the tree - According to God's command in that case, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxi. 22" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p26.1" parsed="|Deut|21|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.21.22">Deut. xxi, 22</scripRef>. The gate of the city - Which place he chose either as most
commodious, now especially when all the city within the gate was already
turned in to an heap of stones and rubbish; or because this was the
usual place of judgment; and therefore proper to bear the monument of
God's just sentence against him, not without reflection upon that
injustice which he had been guilty of in that place.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p27">30. Then - Namely, after the taking of Ai. For they were
obliged to do this, when they were brought over Jordan into the land of
Canaan, <scripRef passage="Deut. xi. 29" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p27.1" parsed="|Deut|11|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.11.29">Deut. xi, 29</scripRef>; xxvii, 2, 3, which is not to be understood strictly, as if
it were to be done the same day; for it is manifest they were first to
be circumcised, and to eat the passover, which they did, and which was
the work of some days; but as soon as they had opportunity to do it,
which was now when these two great frontier cities were taken and
destroyed, and thereby the coast cleared, and the bordering people under
great consternation, so that all the Israelites might securely march
thither. And indeed this work was fit to be done as soon as might be,
that thereby they might renew their covenant with God, by whose help
alone they could expect success in their great and difficult enterprize.
Built an altar - Namely, for the offering of sacrifices, as appears from
the following verse. Mount Ebal - God's altar was to be but in one
place, <scripRef passage="Deut. xii. 13, 14" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p27.2" parsed="|Deut|12|13|12|14" osisRef="Bible:Deut.12.13-Deut.12.14">Deut. xii, 13, 14</scripRef>, and this place was appointed to be mount Ebal, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxvii. 4, 5" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p27.3" parsed="|Deut|27|4|27|5" osisRef="Bible:Deut.27.4-Deut.27.5">Deut. xxvii, 4, 5</scripRef>, which also seems most proper, that in that place whence the
curses of the law were denounced against sinners, there might also be
the tokens and means of grace, and peace, and reconciliation with God,
for the removing of the curses, and the procuring of God's blessing to
sinners.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p28">32. Upon the stones - Not upon the stones of the altar,
which were to be rough and unpolished, ver. 31, but upon other stones,
smooth and plaistered, as is manifest from <scripRef passage="Deut. xxvii. 2" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p28.1" parsed="|Deut|27|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.27.2">Deut. xxvii, 2</scripRef>. The law of Moses - Not certainly the whole five books of
Moses, for what stones and time would have sufficed for this, but the
most weighty parts of the law, and especially the law of the ten
commandments.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p29">33. All Israel - That is, the whole congregation, old and
young, male and female. That side - Some on one side of it, and some on
the other. Mount Gerizim - These two places were in the tribe of
Ephraim, not far from Shechem, as appears both from scripture, and from
other authors. Bless - Or curse, which is easily understood out of the
following verse.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p30">34. Afterward - After the altar was built, and the stones
plaistered and writ upon. He read - That is, he commanded the priests or
Levites to read, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxvii. 14" id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p30.1" parsed="|Deut|27|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.27.14">Deut. xxvii, 14</scripRef>. Blessings and cursings - Which words came in not by way of
explication, as if the words of the law were nothing else besides the
blessings and curses; but by way of addition, to note that these were
read over and above the words of the law.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.viii.ii-p31">35. Read not - Therefore he read not the blessings and
curses only, as some think, but the whole law, as the manner was when
all Israel, men and women, were assembled together, or the ten
commandments. Among them - Who were proselytes, for no others can be
supposed to be with them at this time.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="53.29%" prev="ii.vii.viii.ii" next="ii.vii.ix.i" id="ii.vii.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua IX" id="ii.vii.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.ix-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="53.29%" prev="ii.vii.ix" next="ii.vii.ix.ii" id="ii.vii.ix.i">

<p id="ii.vii.ix.i-p1">The confederacy of the kings of Canaan against Israel,
ver. 1, 2. The confederacy of the Gibeonites with Israel, ver. 3-18.
Their employment, ver. 19-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="53.29%" prev="ii.vii.ix.i" next="ii.vii.x" id="ii.vii.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p1">2. Together - They entered into a league to do this. Tho'
they were many kings of different nations, and doubtless of different
interests, often at variance with each other, yet they are all
determined to unite against Israel. O that Israel would learn this of
Canaanites, to sacrifice private interests to the public good, and to
lay aside all animosities among themselves, that they may cordially
unite against the common enemy.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p2">3. Gibeon - A great and royal city of the Hivites.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p3">4. Been ambassadors - Sent from a far country.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p4">6. The camp at Gilgal - The place of their head-quarters.
Men of Israel - To those who used to meet in council with Joshua, to
whom it belonged to make leagues, even the princes of the congregation.
Now therefore - Because we are not of this people, whom, as we are
informed, you are obliged utterly to destroy.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p5">7. The Hivites - That is, the Gibeonites who were
Hivites, chap. xi, 19. Among us - That is, in this land, and so are of
that people with whom we are forbidden to make any league or
covenant.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p6">8. Thy servants - We desire a league with you upon your
own terms; we are ready to accept of any conditions. From whence came ye
- For this free and general concession gave Joshua cause to suspect that
they were Canaanites.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p7">9. Name of the Lord - Being moved thereunto by the report
of his great and glorious nature and works; so they gave them hopes that
they would embrace their religion. In Egypt - They cunningly mention
those things only which were done some time ago, and say nothing of
dividing Jordan, or the destruction of Jericho and Ai, as if they lived
so far off that the fame of those things had not yet reached them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p8">13. The bottles - Leathern bottles.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p9">14. The men - That is, the princes. Their victuals - That
they might examine the truth of what they said. The mouth of the Lord -
As they ought to have done upon all such weighty occasions. So they are
accused of rashness and neglect of their duty. For though it is
probable, if God had been consulted, he would have consented to the
sparing of the Gibeonites; yet it should have been done with more
caution, and an obligation upon them to embrace the true religion. In
every business of importance, we should stay to take God along with us,
and by the word and prayer consult him. Many a time our affairs
miscarry, because we asked not counsel at the mouth of the Lord. Did we
acknowledge him in all our ways, they would be more safe, easy and
successful.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p10">15. To let them live - That is, they should not destroy
them. That this league was lawful and obliging, appears,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p11">1. Because Joshua and all the princes, upon
the review concluded it so to be, and spared them accordingly.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p12">2. Because God punished the violation of it
long after, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xxi. 1" id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p12.1" parsed="|2Sam|21|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.21.1">2 Sam. xxi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p13">3. Because God is said to have hardened the
hearts of all other cities, not to seek peace with Israel, that so he
might utterly destroy them, chap. xi, 19, 20, which seems to imply that
their utter destruction did not necessarily come upon them by virtue of
any peremptory command of God, but by their own obstinate hardness,
whereby they refused to make peace with the Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p14">16. Three days - That is, at the last of them, or upon
the third day, as it is said, ver. 17.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p15">17. And Kirjath-jearim - Which cities were subject to
Gibeon, the royal city, chap. x, 2.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p16">18. Against the princes - Both from that proneness which
is in people to censure the actions of their rulers; and from their
desire of the spoil of these cities.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p17">21. Unto all the congregation - That is, Let them be
public servants, and employed in the meanest offices, (one kind being
put for all the rest) for the use of the congregation; to do this partly
for the sacrifices and services of the house of God, which otherwise the
Israelites themselves must have done; partly for the service of the camp
or body of the people; and sometimes, even to particular Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p18">22. Called for them - Probably not only the messengers,
but the elders of Gibeon were now present.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p19">23. Ye are cursed - You shall not escape the curse of God
which by divine sentence belongs to all the Canaanites; but only change
the quality of it, you shall feel that curse of bondage, which is proper
to your race by virtue of that ancient decree, <scripRef passage="Gen. ix. 25" id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Gen|9|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.9.25">Gen. ix, 25</scripRef>. Bond-men - The slavery, which is upon you shall be entailed
on your posterity. The house of my God - This only service they mention
here, because it was their durable servitude, being first in the
tabernacle, and then in the temple, whence they were called Nethinim, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ix. 2" id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p19.2" parsed="|1Chr|9|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.9.2">1 Chron. ix, 2</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Ezra ii. 43" id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p19.3" parsed="|Ezra|2|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.2.43">Ezra ii, 43</scripRef>, whereas their servitude to the whole congregation in a
great measure ceased when the Israelites were dispersed to their several
habitations.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p20">25. In thine hand - That is, in thy power to use us as
thou wilt. Unto thee - We refer ourselves to thee and thy own piety, and
probity, and faithfulness to thy word and oath; if thou wilt destroy thy
humble suppliants, we submit. Let us in like manner submit to our Lord
Jesus, and refer ourselves to him; saying, We are in thy hand; do unto
us as seemeth right unto thee. Only save our souls: give us our lives
for a prey; and let us serve thee, just as thou wilt!</p>

<p id="ii.vii.ix.ii-p21">27. The altar of the Lord - By which appears, that they
were not only to do this service in God's house, but upon all other
occasions, as the congregation needed their help.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="53.39%" prev="ii.vii.ix.ii" next="ii.vii.x.i" id="ii.vii.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua X" id="ii.vii.x-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.x-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="53.39%" prev="ii.vii.x" next="ii.vii.x.ii" id="ii.vii.x.i">

<p id="ii.vii.x.i-p1">In this chapter we have an account of the confederacy
against Gibeon, and the request of the Gibeonites to Joshua, ver. 1-6.
Of Joshua's marching and defeating the confederate kings, ver. 7-11. Of
the sun's standing still, ver. 12-14. Of the execution of the kings,
ver. 15-27. Of the taking their cities, and conquering all that country,
ver. 28-42. Of the return of the army to Gilgal, ver. 43.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="53.39%" prev="ii.vii.x.i" next="ii.vii.xi" id="ii.vii.x.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p1">1. Among them - That is, were conversant with them, had
submitted to their laws, and mingled interests with them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p2">2. Thy - That is, he and his people, the king being
spoken of ver. 1, as a publick person representing all his people. Royal
cities - Either really a royal city, or equal to one of the royal
cities, though it had no king, but seems to have been governed by
elders, chap. ix, 11.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p3">3. Adoni-zedek sent - Either because he was superior to
them, or because he was nearest the danger, and most forward in the
work.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p4">5. Of the Amorites - This name being here taken largely
for any of the Canaanites, as is frequent; for, to speak strictly, the
citizens of Hebron here mentioned, ver. 3, were Hittites. It is
reasonably supposed, that the Amorites being numerous and victorious
beyond Jordan poured forth colonies into the land of Canaan, subdued
divers places, and so communicated their name to all the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p5">6. Slack not thy hand - Do not neglect or delay to help
us. Whom thou art obliged to protect both in duty as thou art our
master; and by thy owns interest, we being part of thy possessions; and
in ingenuity, because we have given ourselves to thee, and put ourselves
under thy protection. In the mountains - ln the mountainous country.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p6">7. Joshua ascended - Having no doubt asked advice of God
first, which is implied by the answer God gives him, ver. 8. All the
mighty men - That is, an army of the most valiant men picked out from
the rest; for it is not probable, either that he would take so many
hundred thousands with him, which would have hindered one another, or
that he would leave the camp without an army to defend it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p7">9. Came suddenly - Though assured by God of the victory,
yet he uses all prudent means. All night - It is not said, that he went
from Gilgal to Gibeon in a night's space; but only that he travelled all
night; unto which you may add part either of the foregoing or of the
following day. It is true, God had promised, that he would without fail
deliver the enemies into his hand. But God's promises are intended, not
to slacken, but to quicken our endeavours. He that believeth doth not
make haste, to anticipate providence; but doth make haste to attend it,
with a diligent, not a distrustful speed.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p8">10. At Gibeon - Hebrew. in Gibeon, not in the city, but
in the territory belonging to it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p9">11. Great stones - That is, hailstones of extraordinary
greatness, cast down with that certainty, as to hit the Canaanites and
not their pursuers the Israelites. Josephus affirms, that thunder and
lightning were mixed with the hail, which may seem probable from <scripRef passage="Hab. iii. 11" id="ii.vii.x.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Hab|3|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hab.3.11">Hab. iii, 11</scripRef>. They had robbed the true God of his honour, by worshipping
the host of heaven, and now the hosts of heaven fights against them, and
triumphs in their ruin. Beth-horon lay north of Gibeon, Azekah and
Makkedah, south, so that they fled each way. But which way soever they
fled, the hailstones pursued them. There is no fleeing out of the hands
of God!</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p10">12. Spoke Joshua - Being moved to beg it out of zeal to
destroy God's enemies, and directed to it by the motion of God's spirit,
and being filled with holy confidence of the success, he speaks the
following words before the people, that that they might be witnesses. In
the sight - That is, in the presence and audience of Israel. Over Gibeon
- That is, in that place and posture in which now it stands towards, and
looks upon Gibeon. Let it not go down lower, and by degrees, out of the
sight of Gibeon. It may seem, that the sun, was declining, and Joshua
perceiving that his work was great and long, and his time but short,
begs of God the lengthening out of the day, and that the sun and moon
might stop their course, He mentions two places, Gibeon and Ajalon, not
as if the sun stood over the one and the moon over the other, which is
absurd especially these places being so near the one to the other; but
partly to vary the phrase, as is common in poetical passages; partly
because he was in his march in the pursuit of his enemies, to pass from
Gibeon to Ajalon; and he begs that he may have the help of longer light
to pursue them, and to that end that the sun might stand still, and the
moon also; not that he needed the moon's light, but because it was fit,
either that both sun and moon should go, or that both should stand still
to prevent disorder in the heavenly bodies. The prayer is thus exprest
with authority, because it was not an ordinary prayer, but the prayer of
a prophet, divinely inspired at this very time for this purpose. And yet
it intimates to us the prevalency of prayer in general, and may mind us
of that honour put upon prayer, concerning the work of my hands command
you me.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p11">13. Avenged them on their enemies - That is, till they
bad utterly destroyed them. Book of Jasher - This book was written and
published before Joshua wrote his, and so is fitly alluded here. But
this, as well as some other historical books, is lost, not being a
canonical book, and therefore not preserved by the Jews with the same
care as they were. The sun stood - Here is no mention of the moon,
because the sun's standing was the only thing which Joshua desired and
needed; and the moon's standing he desired only by accident to prevent
irregularity in the motions of those celestial lights. And if it seem
strange to any one, that so wonderful a work should not be mentioned in
any Heathen writers; he must consider, that it is confessed by the
generality of writers, Heathens and others, that there is no certain
history or monument in Heathen authors of any thing done before the
Trojan war, which was a thousand years after Joshua's time; and that all
time before that, is called by the most learned Heathens, the uncertain,
unknown, or obscure time. A whole day - That is, for the space of a
whole day. Understand an artificial day between sun-rising and
sun-setting; for that was the day which Joshua needed and desired, a day
to give him light for his work.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p12">14. No day like that - Namely, in those parts of the
world in which he here speaks, vain therefore is that objection, that
the days are longer near the northern and southern poles, where they are
constantly longer at certain seasons, and that by the order of nature;
whereas the length of this day was purely contingent, and granted by God
in answer to Joshua's prayer. The Lord hearkened to a man - Namely, in
such a manner to alter the course of nature, and of the heavenly bodies,
that a man might have more time to pursue and destroy his enemies. The
Lord fought - This is added as the reason why God was so ready to answer
Joshua's petition, because he was resolved to fight for Israel, and that
in a more than ordinary manner. But this stupendous miracle was designed
for something more, than to give Israel light to destroy the Canaanites.
It was designed to convince and confound those idolaters, who worshipped
the sun and moon, by demonstrating, that these also were subject to the
command of the God of Israel: as also to signify, that in the latter
days, when the world was covered with darkness, the sun of
righteousness, even our Joshua, should arise, and be the true light of
the world. To which we may add, that when Christ conquered our enemies
upon the cross, the miracle wrought on the sun was the reverse of this.
It was then darkened, as if going down at noon. For Christ needed not
the light of the sun, to compleat his victory: so he made darkness his
pavilion.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p13">15. Joshua returned - Not upon the same day, but after he
had dispatched the matter which here follows; as appears by ver. 43,
where the very same words are repeated. And they are put here to close
the general discourse of the fight which begun ver. 10, and ends here;
which being done he particularly describes some remarkable passages, and
closeth them with the same words.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p14">16. A cave - A place of the greatest secrecy; but there
is no escaping the eye or hand of God. At Makkedah - Hebrew. in
Makkedah, not in the city, for that was not yet taken; but in the
territory of it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p15">19. Enter their cities - Whereby they will recover their
strength, and renew the war. God hath delivered them - Your work will be
easy, God hath already done the work to your hands.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p16">20. The children of Israel - That is, a party of them by
the command of Joshua; for Joshua himself went not with them, but abode
in the siege before Makkedah, ver. 21.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p17">21. To the camp - To the body, of the army which were
engaged there with Joshua to besiege that place. None moved his tongue -
Not only their men of war could not find their hands, but they were so
confounded, that they could not move their tongues in way of insult, as
doubtless they did when the Israelites were smitten at Ai; but now they
were silenced as well as conquered: they durst no more provoke the
Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p18">24. Put your feet on the necks - This he did not from
pride and contempt; but as a punishment of their impious rebellion
against their Sovereign Lord; in pursuance of that curse of servitude
due to all this people, and as a token to assure his captains, that God
would subdue the proudest of them under their feet.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p19">27. Took them down - That neither wild beasts could come
to devour them, nor any of their people to give them honourable burial.
Thus that which they thought would have been their shelter, was made
their prison first, and then their grave. So shall we surely be
disappointed, in whatever we flee to from God.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p20">28. And that day - On which the sun stood still. Nor is
it strange that so much work was done, and places so far distant taken
in one day, when the day was so long, and the Canaanites struck with
such a terror.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p21">29. All Israel - Namely, who were with him in this
expedition.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p22">35. On that day - On which they first attempted it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p23">36. Unto Hebron - The conquest of Hebron is here
generally related, afterwards repeated, and more particularly described,
chap. xv, 13, 14.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p24">37. All the cities - Which were subject to its
jurisdiction; this being, it seems, a royal city as Gibeon was, ver. 2,
and having cities under it as that had.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p25">38. Joshua returned - He is said to return thither, not
as if he had been there before, but because having gone as far westward
and southward as he thought fit, even as far as Gaza, ver. 41, he now
returned towards Gilgal, which lay north-ward and eastward from him, and
in his return fell upon Debir.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p26">40. All that breathed - That is, all mankind, they
reserved the cattle for their own uses. As God had commanded - This is
added for the vindication of the Israelites, whom God would not have to
suffer in their reputation for executing his commands; and therefore he
acquits them of that cruelty, which they might be thought guilty of, and
ascribes it to his own just indignation. And hereby was typified the
final destruction of all the impenitent enemies of the Lord Jesus, who
having slighted the riches of his grace, must forever feel the weight
of his wrath.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.x.ii-p27">41. Kadesh-barnea - Which lay in the south of Canaan, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxiv. 4" id="ii.vii.x.ii-p27.1" parsed="|Num|34|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.34.4">Num. xxxiv, 4</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Deut. i. 19" id="ii.vii.x.ii-p27.2" parsed="|Deut|1|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.1.19">Deut. i, 19</scripRef> chap. xv, 3. Gaza - Which was in the southwest of Canaan. So
he here signifies, that Joshua did in this expedition subdue all those
parts which lay south and west from Gilgal. Goshen - Not that Goshen in
Egypt, but another in Judah.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="53.59%" prev="ii.vii.x.ii" next="ii.vii.xi.i" id="ii.vii.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XI" id="ii.vii.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xi-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="53.59%" prev="ii.vii.xi" next="ii.vii.xi.ii" id="ii.vii.xi.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xi.i-p1">The confederacy of many kings against Israel, ver. 1-5.
God's encouragement to Joshua, and his conquest of them and their
cities, ver. 6-20. The destruction of the Anakims, ver. 21-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="53.59%" prev="ii.vii.xi.i" next="ii.vii.xii" id="ii.vii.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p1">1. Hazor - The chief city of those parts, ver. 10. Had
heard - This was a remarkable instance of the wisdom and goodness of
Divine Providence, which so governed the minds of the Canaanites, that
they were not all united under one king, but divided amongst many petty
kings; and next, that these did not all unanimously join their counsels
and forces together to oppose the Israelites at their first entrance,
but quietly suffered the destruction of their brethren, thereby
preparing the way for their own.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p2">2. On the north - The general designation of all the
particular places following: they were in the northern parts of Canaan,
as those mentioned chap. x, 1-43, were in the southern parts; in the
mountain, either in or near the mountain of Lebanon, called the mountain
by way of eminency; or in the mountainous country. Cinneroth - Hebrew.
in the plain lying southward from Cinneroth, or the lake of Genesareth.
Dor - A place upon the coast of the midland-sea.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p3">3. The Canaanite - The Canaanites properly so called,
lived part of them on the east near Jordan, and part on the west near
the sea, and both are here united. The Hivite - That dwelt under mount
Hermon in the north of Canaan, whereby they are differenced from those
Hivites who lived in Gibeon. Mizpeh - That Mizpeh which was in the
northern part of Gilead. But there are other cities called by that name,
which signifying a watching-place, might be easily applied to several
places of good prospect.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p4">5. Merom - A lake made by the river Jordan in the
northern part of it, which was in the territory of the King of Schimron,
near Hazor, Jabin's royal city, and almost in the middle of these
confederate kings.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p5">6. Hough their horses - Cut their hamstrings that they
may my be unfit for war. For God forbad them to keep many horses, now
especially, that they might not trust to their horses, nor ascribe the
conquest of the land to their own strength, but wholly to God, by whose
power alone a company of raw and unexperienced footmen were able to
subdue so potent a people, who besides their great numbers, and giants,
and walled cities, had the advantage of many thousands of horses and
chariots.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p6">7. Suddenly - When they least expected them, intending
there to refresh, and prepare, and order themselves for the offensive
war which they designed.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p7">8. Great Zidon - A great city in the northwest part of
Canaan, upon the sea. Misrephoth-maim - A place not far from Zidon,
supposed to be so called from the salt or glass which they made there.
Valley of Mizpeh - Under mount Hermon, as appears by comparing this with
ver. 3, and 17. where it seems to be called the valley of Lebanon. This
lay on the east, as Zidon did on the west; and so it seems they fled
several ways, and the Israelites also divided themselves into two
bodies, one pursuing east, and the other west.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p8">10. The king - In his royal city, to which he fled out of
the battle. Head of these kingdoms - Not of all Canaan, but of all those
who were confederate with him in this expedition.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p9">11. Not any left - That is, no human person.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p10">13. In their strength - Hebrew. with their fence, walls
or bulwarks, that is, which were not ruined with their walls in taking
them. Save Hazor - Because this city began the war, and being the chief
and royal city, might renew the war. If the Canaanites should ever seize
upon it: which in fact they did, and settled there, under a king of the
same name, <scripRef passage="Judg. iv. 2" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Judg|4|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.4.2">Judg. iv, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p11">16. All that land - Of Canaan, whose parts here follow.
The hill - Or, the mountain, that is, the mountainous country, namely,
of Judea. A considerable part of Judea was called the hilly or the
mountainous country, <scripRef passage="Luke i. 39, 65" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Luke|1|39|0|0;|Luke|1|65|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.1.39 Bible:Luke.1.65">Luke i, 39, 65</scripRef>. The south country - That is, not only the mountainous part,
but all the country of Judea, which lay in the southern part of Canaan,
and often comes under the name of the south. The vale - The low
countries. The plain - The fields or campaign grounds. The mountain of
Israel - The mountains or mountainous country of Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p12">17. To Seir - That is, To the country of Seir or Edom;
namely, that part of it which was south from Judea, not that which was
eastward from it, as appears from hence, that here is mention of the two
extreme bounds of the land conquered by Joshua; whereof the other which
follows being in the north, this must needs be in the south of the land.
Baal-Gad - A part of mount Lebanon.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p13">18. A long time - For divers years together, as is
evident by the following history. And this is here expressed, lest it
should be thought that as all these wars are here recorded in a short
narration, so they were dispatched in a short time. And God would have
the land to be conquered gradually, for many weighty reasons;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p14">1. Lest the sudden extirpation of those
nations should have made a great part of the land desert, and thereby
have increased the number of wild beasts, <scripRef passage="Deut. vii. 22" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Deut|7|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.7.22">Deut. vii, 22</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p15">2. Lest being done suddenly and easily, it
should soon be forgotten and despised, as the nature of man is apt to do
in those cases.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p16">3. That by long exercise the Israelites
might grow skilful in the art of war.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p17">4. For the trial and exercise of their
patience and courage, and trust in God.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p18">5. To oblige them to the greater care to
please God, whom they yet need for their help against their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p19">19. All other - Namely, all that were taken by Joshua,
were taken by the sword, and therefore it is no wonder that the war was
long, when the enemy was so obstinate.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p20">20. To harden their hearts - It was the design of God's
providence not to soften their hearts to a compliance with the
Israelites, but to give them up to their own animosity, pride,
confidence and stubbornness; that so their abominable and incorrigible
wickedness might be punished, and that the Israelites might not be mixed
with them, but be entire among themselves in the possession of the
land.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p21">21. At that time - In that war, but in divers years. The
mountain - Or, mountains, the singular number for the plural; these
barbarous and monstrous persons either chose to live in the dens or
caves, which were frequent in the mountains of those parts, or else they
were driven thither by the arms and success of the Israelites. From
Debir - From the territories belonging to these cities, as we have often
seen in this history, cities mentioned for the country subject to them.
The mountains of Israel - It doth not follow from hence, that this book
was written by some other person long after Joshua's death, even after
the division of the Israelites into two kingdoms. of Israel and Judah;
but only that this was one of those clauses which were added by Ezra or
some other prophet; though that be not necessary: for since it was
evident to Joshua, from <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 10" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p21.1" parsed="|Gen|49|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.10">Gen. xlix, 10</scripRef>, &amp;c. that the tribe of Judah was to be the chief of all
these tribes, and some dawnings of its eminency appeared in that time,
in their having the first lot in the land of Canaan, chap. xv, 1, and
the largest inheritance, chap. xix, 9, it is no wonder that it is
mentioned apart, and distinguished from the rest of the tribes of
Israel, though that also be one of them. But how could Joshua utterly
destroy these, when Caleb and Othniel destroyed some of them after
Joshua's death? chap. xiv, 12<scripRef passage="Judg. i. 10-12" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p21.2" parsed="|Judg|1|10|1|12" osisRef="Bible:Judg.1.10-Judg.1.12">Judg. i, 10-12</scripRef>. This might be, either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p22">1. Because these places being in part
destroyed and neglected by the Israelites, were repossessed by the
giants, and by them kept 'till Caleb destroyed them. Or rather</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p23">2. Because this work, though done by the
particular valour of Caleb, is ascribed to Joshua as the general of the
army, according to the manner of all historians; and therefore it is
here attributed to Joshua, though afterwards, that Caleb might not lose
his deserved honour, the history is more particularly described, and
Caleb owned as the great instrument of it, chap. xiv, 6-15 and <scripRef passage="Judg. i. 12-20" id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p23.1" parsed="|Judg|1|12|1|20" osisRef="Bible:Judg.1.12-Judg.1.20">Judg. i, 12-20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xi.ii-p24">23. The whole land - That is, the greatest and best part
of it, for some parts are expressly excepted in the following history.
All that the Lord said unto Moses - God had promised to drive out the
nations before them. And now the promise was fulfilled. Our successes
and enjoyments are then doubly comfortable, when we see them flowing to
us from the promise. This is according to what the Lord hath said: our
obedience is acceptable, when it has an eye to the precept. And if we
make a conscience of our duty, we need not question the performance of
the promise.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="53.74%" prev="ii.vii.xi.ii" next="ii.vii.xii.i" id="ii.vii.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XII" id="ii.vii.xii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="53.74%" prev="ii.vii.xii" next="ii.vii.xii.ii" id="ii.vii.xii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xii.i-p1">The conquests of Israel, under Moses, ver. 1-6. Under
Joshua, ver. 7-24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="53.74%" prev="ii.vii.xii.i" next="ii.vii.xiii" id="ii.vii.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p1">1. Plain on the east - On the east of Jordan, called the
plain, <scripRef passage="Deut. i. 1" id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Deut|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.1.1">Deut. i, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p2">2. Middle of the river - It is not unusual even among us,
for a river to be divided between two lords, and for their territories
or jurisdictions to meet in the middle of the river: and besides, here
is a very particular reason for this expression, because the city Ar,
which was no part of Sihon's dominions, but belonged to the Moabites, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 9, 18" id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Deut|2|9|0|0;|Deut|2|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.9 Bible:Deut.2.18">Deut. ii, 9, 18</scripRef>, was in the middle of the river Arnon, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 36" id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Deut|2|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.36">Deut. ii, 36</scripRef>; iii, 16, and therefore the middle of the river is properly
here mentioned, as the bound of Sihon's dominion on that side. Half
Gilead - Hebrew. and the half Gilead, that is, half of the country of
Gilead; this doth not denote the bound from which his dominion began,
but the country, over which his dominion was, which began at Arnon, and
took in half Gilead, and ended at Jabbok, beyond which was the other
half of Gilead which belonged to Og.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p3">3. On the east - Which words describe the situation not
of the sea of Cinneroth, which was part of the western border of Sihon's
dominion, but of the plain, which is here said to lie eastward from the
sea of Cinneroth, and also eastward from the salt sea. And this was
indeed the situation of the plains of Moab, which are here spoken of;
they lay between the two seas, that of Cinneroth and the salt sea, and
eastward to them both. Sea of the plain - The salt sea was a famous
plain, pleasant and fruitful, before it was turned into a sea.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p4">4. Ashtaroth and Edrei - Sometimes at the one, sometimes
at the other city; both being his royal mansions. But Israel made one
grave serve him, who could not be contented with one palace.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p5">6. Smile - Fresh mercies must not drown the remembrance
of former mercies: nor must the glory of the present instruments of good
to the church, diminish the just honour of those that went before them.
Joshua's services were confessedly great. But let not those under Moses
be forgotten. Both together proclaim God to be the Alpha and Omega of
his peoples salvation.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p6">8. The wilderness - This word here and elsewhere in
scripture notes not a land wholly desert and uninhabited, but one thin
of inhabitants, as <scripRef passage="1 Kings ii. 34" id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|1Kgs|2|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.2.34">1 Kings ii, 34</scripRef>; ix, 18 <scripRef passage="Matt. iii. 1, 3" id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Matt|3|1|0|0;|Matt|3|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.3.1 Bible:Matt.3.3">Matt. iii, 1, 3</scripRef>. The Gargashites either were now incorporated with some
other of these nations, or as the tradition of the Jews is, upon the
approach of Israel under Joshua, they all withdrew and went unto Africk,
leaving their land to be possessed by the Israelites, with whom they
saw, it was fruitless to contend.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p7">23. King of Gilgal - Not of that Gilgal where Joshua
first lodged after his passage over Jordan; where it doth not appear,
that there was either king or city; but of a city of the same name,
probably in Galilee towards the sea, where divers people might possibly
resort for trade and merchandise, over whom this was a king, as formerly
Tidal seems to have been, <scripRef passage="Gen. xiv. 1" id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Gen|14|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.14.1">Gen. xiv, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xii.ii-p8">24. Thirty one - Each being king only of one city or
small province belonging to it, which was by the wise and singular
providence of God, that they might be more easily conquered. But what a
fruitful land must Canaan then be, which could subsist so many kingdoms!
And yet at this day it is one of the most barren and despicable
countries in the world. Such is the effect of the curse it lies under,
since its inhabitants rejected the Lord of glory!</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="53.80%" prev="ii.vii.xii.ii" next="ii.vii.xiii.i" id="ii.vii.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XIII" id="ii.vii.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xiii-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="53.80%" prev="ii.vii.xiii" next="ii.vii.xiii.ii" id="ii.vii.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.i-p1">God informs Joshua what parts of the land were yet
unconquered, and orders him to divide what was conquered, ver. 1-7. A
repetition of the division made by Moses, first, in general, ver. 8-14.
then in particular: the lot of Reuben, ver. 15-23. Of Gad, ver. 24-28.
Of the half tribe of Manasseh, ver. 29-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="53.81%" prev="ii.vii.xiii.i" next="ii.vii.xiv" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p1">1. Thou art old - Therefore delay not to do the work
which I have commanded thee to do. It is good for those that are
stricken in years, to be remembered that they are so: that they may be
quickened to do the work of life, and prepare for death which is coming
on apace.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p2">2. Remaineth - Unconquered by thee, and to be conquered
by the Israelites, if they behave themselves aright. All Geshuri - A
people in the northeast of Canaan, as the Philistines are on the
southwest.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p3">3. Counted to the Canaanites - That is, which though now
possessed by the Philistines, who drove out the Canaanites the old
inhabitants of it, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 23" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Deut|2|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.23">Deut. ii, 23</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Amos ix. 7" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p3.2" parsed="|Amos|9|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Amos.9.7">Amos ix, 7</scripRef>, yet is a part of the land of Canaan, and therefore belongs
to the Israelites. The Avites - Or, the Avims, as they are called, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 23" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p3.3" parsed="|Deut|2|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.23">Deut. ii, 23</scripRef>, who though they were expelled out of their ancient seat,
and most of them destroyed by the Caphtorims or Philistines, as is there
said, yet many of them escaped, and planted themselves not very far from
the former.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p4">4. From the south - That is, from those southern parts of
the sea- coast, now possessed by the Philistines, all the more northern
parts of the sea-coast being yet inhibited by the Canaanites, almost as
far as Sidon. The Amorites - The Amorites were a very strong and
numerous people, and we find them dispersed in several parts, some
within Jordan, and some without it, some in the south and others in the
north, of whom he speaks here.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p5">6. Will I drive out - Whatever becomes of us, however we
may be laid aside as broken vessels, God will do his work in his own
time. I will do it by my word; so the Chaldee here, as in many other
places: by the eternal word, the captain of my host. But the promise of
driving them out from before the children of Israel, supposes that the
Israelites must use their own endeavours, must go up against them. If
Israel, thro' sloth or cowardice let them alone, they are not likely to
be driven out. We must go forth on our Christian warfare, and then God
will go before us.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p6">8. Which Moses gave them - By my command, and therefore
do not thou disturb them in their possessions, but proceed to divide the
other possessions to the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p7">9. Medeba unto Dibon - Two cities anciently belonging to
the Moabites, and taken from them by the Amorites, <scripRef passage="Num. xxi. 30" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Num|21|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.21.30">Num. xxi, 30</scripRef>, and from them by the Israelites; and after the Israelites
were gone into captivity, recovered by the first possessors, the
Moabites.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p8">11. And Maacathites - Whose land God had given to the
Israelites without Jordan, though they had not yet used the gift of God,
nor taken possession of it, as is noted, ver. 13.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p9">12. These did Moses smite - Not all now mentioned, but
Sihon and Og, and their people, and the generality of them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p10">14. He gave - That is, Moses. None inheritance - Namely,
in the land beyond Jordan, where yet a considerable part of the Levites
were to have their settled abode. This is mentioned as the reason both
why Moses gave all that land to the Reubenites and Gadites and
Manassites; and why Joshua should divide the land only into nine parts
and an half, as was said, ver. 7, because Levi was otherwise provided
for. Made by fire - Which are here put for all the sacrifices and
oblations, including first-fruits and tithes, that were assigned to the
Levites; and this passage is repeated, to prevent those calumnies and
injuries which God foresaw the Levites were likely to meet with, from
the malice, envy and covetousness of their brethren.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p11">15. According to their families - Dividing the
inheritance into as many parts as they had families; but this is only
spoken of the greater families; for the lesser distributions to the
several small families was done by inferior officers, according to the
rules which Moses gave them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p12">19. In the mount of the valley - In the mountain
bordering upon that valley, which then was famous among the Israelites;
whether that where Moses was buried, which was near to Beth-peor, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxiv. 1, 6" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Deut|34|1|0|0;|Deut|34|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.34.1 Bible:Deut.34.6">Deut. xxxiv, 1, 6</scripRef>, or some other. And this clause is thought to belong to all
the cities now mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p13">21. Cities of the plain - Opposed to the cities of the
mountain of the valley. All the kingdom of Sihon - A great part of it;
in which sense we read of all Judea, and all the region round about
Jordan, <scripRef passage="Matt. iii. 5" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Matt|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.3.5">Matt. iii, 5</scripRef>, and all Galilee, <scripRef passage="Matt. iv. 23" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p13.2" parsed="|Matt|4|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.4.23">Matt. iv, 23</scripRef>. Whom Moses smote - Not in the same time or battle, as
appears by comparing <scripRef passage="Num. xxi. 23, 24" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p13.3" parsed="|Num|21|23|21|24" osisRef="Bible:Num.21.23-Num.21.24">Num. xxi, 23, 24</scripRef>, with <scripRef passage="Num. xxxi. 8" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p13.4" parsed="|Num|31|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.31.8">Num. xxxi, 8</scripRef>, but in the same manner. And they are here mentioned, partly
because they were slain not long after, and upon the same occasion, even
their enmity against Israel; and partly because of their relation and
subjection to Sihon. Dukes of Sihon - But how could they be so, when
they were kings of Midian? <scripRef passage="Num. xxxi. 8" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p13.5" parsed="|Num|31|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.31.8">Num. xxxi, 8</scripRef>. There were divers petty kings in those parts, who were
subject to greater kings; and such these were, but are here called dukes
or princes of Sihon, because they were subject and tributaries to him,
and therefore did one way or other assist Sihon in this war, though they
were not killed at this time. It is probable, that when Sihon destroyed
those Moabites which dwelt in these parts, he frighted the rest of them,
and with them their neighbours and confederates, the Midianites, into
some kind of homage, which they were willing to pay him. Dwelling in the
country - Hebrew. inhabiting that land, namely Midian, last mentioned;
whereby he signifies, that tho' they were subject to Sihon, yet they did
not dwell in his land, but in another.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p14">22. Were slain by them - This was recorded before, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxi. 8" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Num|31|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.31.8">Num. xxxi, 8</scripRef>, and is here repeated, because the defeating of Balaam's
purpose to curse Israel, and the turning that curse into a blessing, was
such an instance of the power and goodness of God, as was fit to be had
in everlasting remembrance.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p15">23. The border thereof - That is, those cities or places
which bordered upon Jordan.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p16">25. The cities of Gilead - That is, all the cities of
eminency; all the cities properly so called, which lay in that part of
Gilead; and so this may well agree with ver. 31, where half the country
of Gilead is said to be given to the Manassites; but there is no mention
of any cities there. The land of the children of Ammon - Not of that
which was now theirs, for that they were forbidden to meddle with, but
of that which was anciently theirs, 'till taken from them by the
Amorites, from whom the Israelites took it. Aroer - The border between
them and Moab. Rabbah - The chief city of the Ammonites.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p17">26. Ramath-mizpeh - Called Ramoth-Gilead, or Ramoth in
Gilead. Mahanaim - Exclusively; for Mahanaim was in the portion of
Manasseh, beyond Jabbok, which was the border of Gad and Manasseh.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p18">27. The rest of the kingdom - The northern part of his
kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p19">29. Of Manasseh - Not that thou desired it, as Reuben and
Gad did, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxii. 1" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Num|32|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.32.1">Num. xxxii, 1</scripRef>, but partly as a recompence to Machir the Manassite, for his
valiant acts against Og; and partly for the better defense of the other
two tribes, by so considerable an accession to them, which also was
without any inconvenience to them, because the country was too large for
the two tribes of Reuben and Gad.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p20">30. Of Jair - Who, though of the tribe of Judah, by the
father, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ii. 21, 22" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p20.1" parsed="|1Chr|2|21|2|22" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.2.21-1Chr.2.22">1 Chron. ii, 21, 22</scripRef>, yet is called the son of Manasseh, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxii. 41" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p20.2" parsed="|Num|32|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.32.41">Num. xxxii, 41</scripRef>, because he married a daughter of Manasseh, and wholly
associated himself with those valiant Manassites; and with their help
took sixty cities or great towns, <scripRef passage="Deut. iii. 4, 14" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p20.3" parsed="|Deut|3|4|0|0;|Deut|3|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.3.4 Bible:Deut.3.14">Deut. iii, 4, 14</scripRef>, which thence were called the towns of Jair.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p21">31. Children of Machir - Whom before he called the
children of Manasseh, he now calls the children of Machir, because
Machir was the most eminent, and as it may seem, the only surviving son
of Manasseh, <scripRef passage="Num. xxvi. 29" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p21.1" parsed="|Num|26|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.26.29">Num. xxvi, 29</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="1 Chron. vii. 14-16" id="ii.vii.xiii.ii-p21.2" parsed="|1Chr|7|14|7|16" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.7.14-1Chr.7.16">1 Chron. vii, 14-16</scripRef>.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="53.94%" prev="ii.vii.xiii.ii" next="ii.vii.xiv.i" id="ii.vii.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XIV" id="ii.vii.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xiv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="53.94%" prev="ii.vii.xiv" next="ii.vii.xiv.ii" id="ii.vii.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.i-p1">The method of dividing the land, ver. 1-5. Caleb demands
Hebron, ver. 6-12. which Joshua grants, ver. 13-15.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="53.95%" prev="ii.vii.xiv.i" next="ii.vii.xv" id="ii.vii.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p1">1. Eleazar the priest - He best understood the laws of
God by which this division was to be regulated. Heads of the fathers -
Twelve persons, each the head of his tribe, who were appointed and named
by God, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxiv. 19" id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Num|34|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.34.19">Num. xxxiv, 19</scripRef>, and if any of them were now dead, no doubt Joshua and
Eleazar, by God's direction, put others in their stead.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p2">2. By lot - This course God ordained, partly to prevent
discontents, enmities and quarrels among the tribes, and partly to
demonstrate the truth and wisdom of his providence, by which alone those
parts fell to each of them, which Jacob long since, and Moses lately,
foretold; so that as a learned man saith, he must be more stupid than
stupidity, that doth not acknowledge a Divine hand in this matter. The
lot did only determine the several parts to the several tribes, but did
not precisely fix all the bounds of it; these might be either enlarged
or diminished according to the greater or smaller number of the
tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p3">4. Were two tribes - That is, had the portion of two
tribes, and therefore though Levi was excluded, there remained nine
tribes and a half, to be provided for in Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p4">5. They - That is, the persons named, ver. 5, who acted
in the name of the children of Israel, divided it, either now, or
presently after.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p5">6. Then - When Joshua and the rest were consulting about
the division of the land, though they did not yet actually divide it.
The heads of that tribe who were willing thus to shew respect to him;
and to testify their consent, that he should be provided for by himself,
and that they would not take it as any reflection on the rest of the
tribe. In Gilgal - Where the division of the land was designed and
begun, though it was executed and finished at Shiloh. The Kenezite - Of
the posterity of Kenaz. The Lord said - In general, the promise he made
us of possessing this land; and for my part, that which is expressed
here, ver. 9.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p6">7. As it was in mine heart - I spake my opinion
sincerely, without flattery and fear, when the other spies were biased
by their own fears, and the dread of the people, to speak otherwise than
in their consciences they believed.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p7">8. I wholly followed the Lord - Which self-commendation
is justifiable, because it was necessary, as being the ground of his
petition. Therefore it was not vain glory in him to speak it: no more
than it is for those, who have God's spirit witnessing with their
spirits, that they are the children of God, humbly and thankfully to
tell others, for their encouragement, what God hath done for their
souls.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p8">10. Forty-five years - Whereof thirty- eight years were
spent in the wilderness, and seven since they came into Canaan. The
longer we live the more sensible we should be, of God's goodness to us
in keeping us alive! Of his care in prolonging our frail lives, his
patience in prolonging our forfeited lives! And shall not the life thus
kept by his providence, be devoted to his praise?</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p9">11. For war - Not only for counsel, but for action; for
marching and fighting. And therefore this gift will not be cast away
upon an unprofitable and unserviceable person. To go out, and to come in
- To perform all the duties belonging to my place. Moses had said, that
at eighty years old, even our strength is labour and sorrow. But Caleb
was an exception to this rule: At eighty-five years old, his strength
was still ease and joy. This he got by following the Lord fully.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p10">12. This mountain - That is, this mountainous country. He
names the country rather than the cities, because the cities were given
to the Levites, chap. xxi, 11, 13. Thou heardest - Didst understand,
both by the reports of others, and by thy own observation. Hearing, the
sense by which we get knowledge, is often put for knowing or
understanding. If the Lord will be with me - A modest and pious
expression, signifying both the absolute necessity of God's help, and
his godly fear, lest God for his sins should deny his assistance to him;
for although he was well assured in general, that God would crown his
people with success in this war, yet he might doubt of his particular
success in this or that enterprize. To drive them out - Out of their
fastnesses where they yet remain, Caleb desires this difficult work as a
testimony of his own faith, and as a motive to quicken his brethren to
the like attempts.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p11">13. Blessed him - Prayed to God to bless and help him
according to his own desire.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xiv.ii-p12">15. A great man - In stature, and strength, and dignity,
and authority, as being the progenitor of Anak, the father of those
famous giants called Anakims.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="54.03%" prev="ii.vii.xiv.ii" next="ii.vii.xv.i" id="ii.vii.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XV" id="ii.vii.xv-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xv-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="54.03%" prev="ii.vii.xv" next="ii.vii.xv.ii" id="ii.vii.xv.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xv.i-p1">The bounds of the inheritance of Judah, ver. 1-12. The
assignment of Hebron to Caleb and his family, ver. 13-19. The cities of
Judah, ver. 20-63.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="54.03%" prev="ii.vii.xv.i" next="ii.vii.xvi" id="ii.vii.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p1">1. The lot - For the general understanding of this, it
must be known</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p2">1. That casting lots was transacted with
great seriousness and solemnity, in God's presence, with prayer and
appeal to him for the decision of the matter.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p3">2. That although exact survey of this land
was not taken 'till chap. xviii, 4, 5, yet there was, and must needs be
a general description of it, and a division thereof into nine parts and
an half; which, as far as they could guess, were equal either in
quantity or quality.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p4">3. That the lot did not at this time so
unchangeably determine each tribe, that their portion could neither be
increased or diminished; as is manifest, because after Judah's lot was
fixed, Simeon's lot was taken out of it, chap. xix, 9, though after the
land was more distinctly known and surveyed, it is likely the bounds
were more certain and fixed.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p5">4. That the lot determined only in general
what part of the land belonged to each tribe, but left the particulars
to be determined by Joshua and Eleazar. For the manner of this, it is
probably conceived, that there was two pots, into one of which were put
the names of all the tribes, each in a distinct paper, and into the
other the names of each portion described; then Eleazar or some other
person, drew out first the name of one of the tribes out of one pot, and
then the name of one portion out of the other, and that portion was
appropriated to that tribe. And with respect to these pots, in the
bottom of which the papers lay, these lots are often said to come up, or
come forth. Of Judah - Whose lot came out first by God's disposition, as
a note of his preeminency above his brethren. Of Edom - Which lay
southeast from Judah's portion. Judah and Joseph were the two sons of
Jacob, on whom Reuben's forfeited birthright devolved. Judah had the
dominion entailed upon him, and Joseph the double portion. Therefore
these two tribes are first seated: and on them the other seven
attended.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p6">2. The bay - Hebrew. the tongue: either a creek or arm of
that sea; or a promontory, which by learned authors is sometimes called
a tongue. Every sea is salt, but this had an extraordinary saltness, the
effect of that fire and brimstone which destroyed Sodom and Gomorrah:
the ruins of which lie buried at the bottom of this dead water, which
never was moved itself by any tides, nor had any living thing in it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p7">5. The end of Jordan - That is, the place where Jordan
runs into the salt-sea.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p8">6. The stone of Bohan - A place so called, not from
Bohan's dwelling there, (for the Reubenites had no portion on this side
Jordan) but from some notable exploit which he did there, though it is
not recorded in scripture.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p9">8. Went up - Properly; for the line went from Jordan and
the salt sea, to the higher grounds nigh Jerusalem; and therefore the
line is said to go down, chap. xviii, 16, because there it takes a
contrary course, and goes downward to Jordan and the sea. Valley of
Hinnom - A very pleasant place, but afterward made infamous. Of the
Jebusites - Of the city of the Jebusites, which was anciently called
Jebussi. Jerusalem - It may seem hence, that Jerusalem properly, or at
least principally, belonged to Benjamin; and yet it is ascribed to Judah
also; either because a part of the city was allotted to Judah; or
because the Benjamites desired the help and conjunction of this powerful
tribe of Judah, for the getting and keeping of this most important
place. And when the Benjamites had in vain attempted to drive out the
Jebusites, this work was at last done by the tribe of Judah, who
therefore had an interest in it by the right of war; as Ziglag which
belonged to the tribe of Simeon, being gotten from the Philistines by
David, was joined by him to his tribe of Judah, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxvii. 6" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p9.1" parsed="|1Sam|27|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.27.6">1 Sam. xxvii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p10">10. Mount Seir - Not that of Edom, but another so called
from some resemblance it had to it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p11">13. He - Joshua. City of Arba - Or, Kirjath-arba. Not the
city, which was the Levites, but the territory of it, chap. xxi, 13.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p12">14. Drove thence - That is, from the said territory, from
their caves and forts in it. These giants having either recovered their
cities, or defended themselves in the mountains. Three sons of Anak -
Either the same who are mentioned, <scripRef passage="Num. xiii. 33" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Num|13|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.13.33">Num. xiii, 33</scripRef>, and so they were long-lived men, such as mainly were in
those times and places: or their sons, called by their father's names,
which is very usual.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p13">15. Debir - The same mentioned above, ver. 7. The name
was Kirjath-sepher - This clause seems to be added to distinguish this
from the other Debir subdued by Joshua, chap. x, 38, 39.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p14">16. To wife - Which is to be understood with some
conditions, as, if he were one who could marry her by God's law; and if
she were willing; for though parents had a great power over their
children, they could not force them to marry any person against their
own wills. He might otherwise be an unfit and unworthy person; but this
was a divine impulse, that Othniel's valour might be more manifest, and
so the way prepared for his future government of the people, <scripRef passage="Judg. iii. 9" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Judg|3|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.3.9">Judg. iii, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p15">18. As she came - Or, as she went, namely, from her
father's house to her husband's, as the manner was. She moved him - She
persuaded her husband, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p16">1. That he would ask: or rather,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p17">2. That he would suffer her to ask, as she
did. She lighted - That she might address herself to her father in an
humble posture, and as a suppliant, which he understood by her
gesture.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p18">19. A blessing - That is, a gift, as that word signifies,
<scripRef passage="Gen. xxxiii. 11" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Gen|33|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.33.11">Gen. xxxiii, 11</scripRef>. A south land - That is, a dry land, much exposed to the
south wind, which in those parts was very hot and drying, as coming from
the deserts of Arabia. Springs of water - That is, a field, wherein are
springs of water, which in that country were of great price; she begs a
well moistened field, which also might give some relief to that which
was dry and barren. Upper and nether springs - Or two fields, one above
and the other below that south and dry ground which she complained of,
that by this means it might be watered on both sides.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p19">32. Twenty nine - Here are thirty seven or thirty eight
cities named before; how then are they only reckoned twenty nine? There
were only twenty nine of them, which either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p20">1. properly belonged to Judah; the rest
fell to Simeon's lot; or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p21">2. Were cities properly so called, that is,
walled cities, or such as had villages under them, as it here follows;
the rest being great, but unwalled towns, or such as had no villages
under them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p22">48. The mountains - That is, in the higher grounds called
mountains or hills, in comparison of the sea-coast.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p23">55. Ziph - Which gave its name to the neighbouring
mountains, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxvi. 1" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p23.1" parsed="|1Sam|26|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.26.1">1 Sam. xxvi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p24">62. City of salt - So called either from the salt sea,
which was near it; or from the salt which was made in, or about it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p25">63. Inhabitants of Jerusalem - For though Jerusalem was
in part taken by Joshua before this; yet the upper and stronger part of
it, called Zion, was still kept by the Jebusites, even until David's
time; and it seems from thence they descended to the lower town called
Jerusalem, and took it so that the Israelites were forced to win it a
second time; yea, and a third time also: for afterwards it was possessed
by the Jebusites, <scripRef passage="Judg. xix. 11" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p25.1" parsed="|Judg|19|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.19.11">Judg. xix, 11</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="2 Sam. v. 6, 7" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p25.2" parsed="|2Sam|5|6|5|7" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.5.6-2Sam.5.7">2 Sam. v, 6, 7</scripRef>. Could not drive them out - Namely, because of their
unbelief, as Christ could do no mighty work, because of the peoples
unbelief, <scripRef passage="Mark vi. 5, 6" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p25.3" parsed="|Mark|6|5|6|6" osisRef="Bible:Mark.6.5-Mark.6.6">Mark vi, 5, 6</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Matt. xiii. 58" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p25.4" parsed="|Matt|13|58|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.13.58">Matt. xiii, 58</scripRef>, and because of their sloth, and cowardice, and wickedness,
whereby they forfeited God's help. The children of Judah - The same
things which are here said of the children of Judah, are said of the
Benjamites, <scripRef passage="Judg. i. 21" id="ii.vii.xv.ii-p25.5" parsed="|Judg|1|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.1.21">Judg. i, 21</scripRef>. Hence ariseth a question, To which of the tribes Jerusalem
belonged? It seems probable, that part of it, and indeed the greatest
part, stood in the tribe of Benjamin; and hence this is mentioned in the
list of their cities, and not in Judah's list; and part of it stood in
Judah's share, even mount Moriah, on which the temple was built; and
Mount Zion, when it was taken from the Jebusites. To this day - When
this book was written, whether in Joshua's life, which continued many
years after the taking of Jerusalem; or after his death, when this
clause was added by some other man of God. But this must be done before
David's time, when the Jebusites were quite expelled, and their fort
taken.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="54.17%" prev="ii.vii.xv.ii" next="ii.vii.xvi.i" id="ii.vii.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XVI" id="ii.vii.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xvi-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="54.17%" prev="ii.vii.xvi" next="ii.vii.xvi.ii" id="ii.vii.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xvi.i-p1">The lot of Ephraim and Manasseh, ver. 1-4. Of Ephraim in
particular, ver. 5-10</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="54.18%" prev="ii.vii.xvi.i" next="ii.vii.xvii" id="ii.vii.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xvi.ii-p1">1. Children of Joseph - That is, of Ephraim, and the half
tribe of Manasseh, which are here put together in one; because in these
first verses he speaks of them in common; and then of their several
portions.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvi.ii-p2">4. Manasseh - That is, half Manasseh. Their inheritance -
Their several portions which here follow. It is said, they took their
inheritance, which also Judah had done before them, because the tribes
of Judah and Joseph did take their inheritances before the rest; and it
was fit they should do so, for the security of the main camp, and the
body of the people which were at Gilgal, chap. xviii, 5.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvi.ii-p3">5. East-side - That is, the northeast side. It is no
wonder, if some of these descriptions are dark to us at this distance of
time; there having been so many alterations made in places, and so many
circumstances, being now altogether undiscoverable. But this is certain,
that all the descriptions here mentioned, were then evident to the
Israelites, because these were the foundations of all the possessions
which then they took, and peaceably possessed in succeeding ages.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvi.ii-p4">6. Toward the sun - The midland sea, towards the
west.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvi.ii-p5">7. To Jericho - Not to the city of Jericho, which
belonged to Benjamin's lot, chap. xviii, 21, but to its territory.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvi.ii-p6">9. The separate cities - That is, besides those cities
which were within Ephraim's bounds, he had some other cities, to which
all of all their territories were annexed out Manasseh's portion,
because his tribe was all here, and was larger than Manasseh's.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="54.20%" prev="ii.vii.xvi.ii" next="ii.vii.xvii.i" id="ii.vii.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XVII" id="ii.vii.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xvii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="54.20%" prev="ii.vii.xvii" next="ii.vii.xvii.ii" id="ii.vii.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.i-p1">The families of Manasseh, ver. 1-6. The country that fell
to their lot, ver. 7-18. Their request for more land, ver. 14-18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="54.21%" prev="ii.vii.xvii.i" next="ii.vii.xviii" id="ii.vii.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p1">1. The first born of Joseph - The sense is, though
Ephraim was to be more potent and numerous, yet Manasseh was the
first-born, and had the privilege of the first-born, which was
translated to Joseph, namely, a double portion; and therefore though
this was but half the tribe of Manasseh, yet they are not made intimates
to Ephraim, but have a distinct lot of their own, as their brethren, or
other half tribe had beyond Jordan. For Machir - The only son of
Manasseh, who therefore is here, put for the whole tribe. The first-born
- So even only sons are sometimes called, as <scripRef passage="Matt. i. 25" id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Matt|1|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.1.25">Matt. i, 25</scripRef>. He - That is, Machir, had given great proof of his valour
(though the particular history be not mentioned) and his posterity were
no degenerate sons, but had his valiant blood still running in their
veins. Gilead and Bashan - Part of these countries; for part of them was
also given to the Reubenites, and part to the Gadites. This may be added
as a reason, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p2">1. why he got those places from the
Amorites: or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p3">2. why they were allotted to him or his
posterity, because this was a frontier country, and the out-works to the
land of Canaan, and therefore required valiant persons to defend it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p4">2. A Lot - A distinct inheritance. The rest - Namely,
those of them which had not received their possessions beyond Jordan.
Male- children - This expression is used to bring in what follows,
concerning his female children.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p5">4. He - That is, Eleazar, or Joshua, with the consent of
the princes appointed for that work.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p6">5. Ten portions - Five for the sons, and five for the
daughters; for as for Hepher, both he and his son Zelophehad was dead,
and that without sons, and therefore had no portion; but his daughters
had several portions allotted to them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p7">6. The daughters - Not less than the son, so the sex was
no bar to their inheritance.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p8">9. Three cities - Tappuah, and the cities upon the coast
descending to the river, &amp;c. last mentioned. Among the cities of
Manasseh - That is, are intermixed with their cities, which was not
strange nor unfit, these two being linked together by a nearer alliance
than the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p9">10. His border - Manasseh's, whose portion is here
described, and whose name was last mentioned. In Asher - That is, upon
the tribe of Asher; for though Zebulon came between Asher and them for
the greatest part of their land; yet it seems there was some necks of
land, both of Ephraim's and of Manasseh's, which jutted out farther than
the rest, and touched the borders of Asher. And it is certain there were
many such incursions of the land of one tribe upon some parcels of
another, although they were otherwise considerably distant one from the
other.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p10">11. Manasseh had in Issachar and in Asher - As Ephraim
had some cities in the tribe of Manasseh, and as it was not unusual,
when the place allotted to any tribe was too narrow for it, and the next
too large, to give away part from the larger to the less portion; nay,
sometimes one whole tribe was taken into another; as Simeon's was into
Judah's portion, when it was found too large for Judah. Inhabitants of
Dor - Not the places only, but the people; whom they spared and used for
servants. Three countries - The words may be rendered, the third part of
that country; and so the meaning may be, that the cities and towns here
mentioned are a third part of that country, that is, of that part of
Issachar's and Asher's portion, in which those places lay.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p11">14. Children of Joseph - That is, of Ephraim and
Manasseh. Spake unto Joshua - That is, expostulated with him, when they
went and saw that portion which was allotted them, and found it much
short of their expectation. One portion - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p12">1. because they really had but one lot,
which was afterwards divided by the arbitrators between them. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p13">2. because the land severally allotted to
them, was but little enough for one of them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p14">15. A great people - He retorts their own argument;
seeing thou art a great and numerous people, turn thy complaints into
action, and enlarge thy borders by thy own hand, to which thou mayest
confidently expect God's assistance. The wood-country - To the mountain,
as it is called, ver. 18, where among some towns there is much
wood-land, which thou mayest without much difficulty possess, and so get
the more room. And cut down - The wood, for thy own advantage; in
building more cities and towns; and preparing the land for pasture and
tillage. The Perizzites - Supposed to be a savage and brutish kind of
people, that lived in woods and mountains. Giants - Who lived in caves
and mountains, now especially when they were driven out of their cities.
If mount Ephraim - Or, seeing mount Ephraim is too narrow for thee, as
thou complainest; take to thyself the rest of that hilly and wood
country. Mount Ephraim was a particular portion of the land, belonging
to the tribe of Ephraim. And this seems to be here mentioned, for all
the portion allotted to Ephraim and Manasseh, as appears from their
complaint, which was not, that this part, but that their whole portion
was too strait for them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p15">16. Is not enough - Hebrew. the hill will not be found,
that is, obtained by us; those fierce and strong people the Perizzites
and the giants will easily defend themselves, and frustrate our
attempts, having the advantage of the woods and mountains. The
Canaanites that dwell - That is, and if thou sayest, that if the hill
either cannot be conquered, or is not sufficient for us, we may go down
and take more land out of the pleasant and fruitful valleys, we shall
meet with no less difficulty there than in the mountains. Chariots of
iron - Not all made of iron, but armed with iron, not only for defense,
but for offense also, having as it were scythes and swords fastened to
them, to cut down all that stood in their way.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p16">17. One lot only - Thou needest and deservedst more than
that lot, of which thou art actually possessed, and thou hast power to
get more; which if thou endeavourest to do, God will bless thee, and
give thee more.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xvii.ii-p17">18. The out-goings of it - The valleys and fields
belonging or adjoining to it, for there the Canaanites were, ver.
16.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="54.31%" prev="ii.vii.xvii.ii" next="ii.vii.xviii.i" id="ii.vii.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XVIII" id="ii.vii.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xviii-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="54.31%" prev="ii.vii.xviii" next="ii.vii.xviii.ii" id="ii.vii.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.i-p1">The setting up of the tabernacle at Shiloh, ver. 1.
Joshua's stirring up the seven remaining tribes to look after their lot,
ver. 2- 7. The division of the land into several lots assigned to those
several tribes, ver. 8-10. The lot of Benjamin, ver. 11-28.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="54.32%" prev="ii.vii.xviii.i" next="ii.vii.xix" id="ii.vii.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p1">1. Set up the tabernacle - By God's appointment. It was
removed from Gilgal, partly for the honour and conveniency of Joshua,
that he being of the tribe of Ephraim, and seating himself there, might
have the opportunity of consulting with God as often as he needed; and
partly for the conveniency of all the tribes, that being in the center
of them, they might more easily resort to it from all places. Here the
tabernacle continued for above three hundred years, even 'till Samuel's
days, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. i. 3" id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|1Sam|1|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.1.3">1 Sam. i, 3</scripRef>. Shiloh was the name given to the Messiah in dying Jacob's
prophecy. So the pitching the tabernacle in Shiloh intimated to the
Jews, that in that Shiloh whom Jacob spoke of, all the ordinances of
this worldly sanctuary should have their accomplishment, in a greater
and more perfect tabernacle.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p2">3. How long are you slack - This slackness is supposed to
arise from an opinion of the impossibility of making any regular
distribution of the parts, 'till the whole were more exactly surveyed,
which accordingly is here done. Likewise, being weary of war, and having
sufficient plenty of all things, they were unwilling to run into new
hazards.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p3">4. Three men - Three, not one, for more exact observation
both of the measure and quality of the several portions, and for greater
assurance of their care and faithfulness in giving in their account. Of
each tribe - One of each of these tribes, who were yet unprovided
for.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p4">5. Seven parts - Which were of equal extent or worth: for
no tribe was so great, but one of these parts in its full extent would
abundantly suffice them; and there was no reason why the portions should
be greater or less according as the tribes at present were more or fewer
in number, because of the various changes which happened therein
successively; it being usual for one tribe to be more numerous than
another in one age, which was fewer in the next. And if the several
tribes had increased more, and not diminished their numbers by their
sins, they might have sent forth colonies, and taken any part of the
land, even as far as Euphrates, all which the Lord of the whole earth
had given them a right to, which when they pleased they might take
possession of. Judah shall abide on the south - They shall not be
disturbed in their possession, but shall keep it, except some part of it
shall be adjudged to another tribe. Joseph on the north - In respect of
Judah, not of the whole land; for divers other tribes were more northern
than they.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p5">6. Before the Lord - That is, before the ark or
tabernacle, that God may be witness and judge, and author of the
division, that each may be contented with his lot, and that your several
possessions may be secured to you as things sacred.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p6">9. By cities - Or, according to the cities, to which the
several parties or territories belonged.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p7">11. And the children of Joseph - Wherein we see the
wisdom of Divine Providence, this being the only place in which that
prophecy, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxiii. 12" id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Deut|33|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.33.12">Deut. xxxiii, 12</scripRef>, could have been accomplished. Providence cast Benjamin next
to Joseph on the one hand, because Benjamin was own and only brother to
Joseph, and next to Judah on the other hand, that this tribe might
hereafter unite with Judah, in an adherence to the throne of David, and
the temple at Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p8">14. Kirjath-jearim - The Israelites changed the name, to
blot out the remembrance of Baal.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p9">16. The end of the mountain - The place where the
mountain ends, and the valley begins. Before the valley - That is, in
the prospect of that valley. In the valley on the north - Which extends
unto this other valley on the north-side of it. Of Jebusi - To that part
where the Jebusites lived, which was in and near Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xviii.ii-p10">21. Jericho - For tho' the city was destroyed, the
territory remained.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="54.38%" prev="ii.vii.xviii.ii" next="ii.vii.xix.i" id="ii.vii.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XIX" id="ii.vii.xix-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xix-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="54.38%" prev="ii.vii.xix" next="ii.vii.xix.ii" id="ii.vii.xix.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xix.i-p1">The lot of Simeon, ver. 1-9. Of Zebulon, ver. 10-16. Of
Issachar, ver. 17-23. Of Asher, ver. 24-31. Of Naphtali, ver. 32- 39. Of
Daniel, ver. 40-48. The inheritance assigned to Joshua and his family,
ver. 49-51.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="54.39%" prev="ii.vii.xix.i" next="ii.vii.xx" id="ii.vii.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p1">1. Within the inheritance of Judah - This was so ordered
by God's providence, partly to fulfil that threatning that he would
divide and scatter this tribe in Israel, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 7" id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|49|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.7">Gen. xlix, 7</scripRef>, which was hereby done in part, because they had no distinct
lot, but were as inmates to Judah; partly, because now upon the more
exact survey of the land, it appeared, that the part given to Judah did
far exceed the proportion which they needed, or which the other tribes
could expect. And this was the least of the tribes, <scripRef passage="Num. xxvi. 14" id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Num|26|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.26.14">Num. xxvi, 14</scripRef>, and therefore fittest to be put within another tribe.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p2">11. Toward the sea - The lot of this tribe was washed by
the midland sea on the west, and by the sea of Tiberias on the east,
answering Jacob's prophecy, Zebulun shall be an haven of ships; trading
ships on the great sea, and fishing ships on the sea of Galilee. Before
Jokneam - Supposed to be Kishon.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p3">15. Beth-lehem - Not that where Christ was born, which
was in Judah, but another. Twelve cities - There are more numbered here,
but the rest either were not cities properly so called, or were not
within this tribe, but only bordering upon it, and belonging to other
tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p4">18. Jezreel - The royal city, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xxi. 1" id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Kgs|21|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.21.1">1 Kings xxi, 1</scripRef>. This tribe, because it lay between Benjamin on the south,
and Zebulun on the north, is not here described by its borders, which
were the same with theirs; but by some of its cities.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p5">26. Carmel west-ward - Or, Carmel by the sea, to
distinguish it from Carmel in the tribe of Judah. This was a place of
eminent fruitfulness, agreeable to the prophecy concerning Asher, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 20" id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|49|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.20">Gen. xlix, 20</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p6">27. Cubal - A city so called. Left hand - That is, on the
north, which, when men look towards the east, as is usual, is on their
left hand.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p7">28. Kenah - Namely, Kenah the greater, in the upper
Galilee; not Kenah the less, which was in the lower Galilee. Zidon -
Called great for its antiquity, and riches, and glory. The city either
was not given to the Israelites, or at least was never possessed by
them; not without a singular providence of God, that they might not by
the opportunity of so good a port, be engaged in much commerce with
other nations; from which, together with wealth, that great corrupter of
mankind, they might contract their errors and vices.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p8">29. To Ramah - From the north southward. To Tyre -
Exclusively, for this city was no part of the land given them. But this
was not the same city we read of afterwards. For that was built on an
island, this on the continent. Probably into these strong holds Tyre and
Sidon, many of the Canaanites fled, when Joshua invaded them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p9">30. Twenty two cities - Here are more named, but some of
them were not within this tribe, but only bordering places.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p10">33. Their coast - Their northern border drawn from west
to east, as appears, because when this coast is described and brought to
its end, the coast is said to turn from the east westward, ver. 34. The
out-goings - The end of that coast.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p11">35. Cinnereth - Whence the lake of Cinnereth or
Genesareth received its name.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p12">41. Of their inheritance - Which is here described only
by its cities, not its borders, which are in part the same with Judah's,
and their inheritance is in good part taken out of Judah's too large
portion; as appears from divers of the cities here mentioned, which are
also reckoned in Judah's portion.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p13">47. Went up to fight - This was done after Joshua's
death, and seems to be here inserted, that all the chief places where
the Danites dwelt, tho' far distant, might be mentioned together; and to
give an account of this strange accident, why they removed from their
appointed portion to so remote a place; which may be this, that being
much molested by their bad neighbours, they thought fit to go to some
place remote from them, which also they were in a manner constrained to
do, because otherwise they must have taken some part of the portions of
other tribes, whereas now going to the very utmost northern point of the
land, they took that which did not belong to any other tribe.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p14">49. The children of Israel - That is, they are said to
give it, because the whole land was given to Joshua, and Eleazar, and
the princes, as joint trustees, acting in the name, and for the good of
the people: so that even Joshua could take nothing without their
gift.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p15">50. The word of The Lord - As God had promised, or
commanded; either formerly, or at this time by Eleazar. He built - That
is, repaired and enlarged it, in which sense Nebuchadnezzar is said to
have built Babylon, <scripRef passage="Dan. iv. 30" id="ii.vii.xix.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Dan|4|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.4.30">Dan. iv, 30</scripRef>.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="54.47%" prev="ii.vii.xix.ii" next="ii.vii.xx.i" id="ii.vii.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XX" id="ii.vii.xx-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xx-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="54.47%" prev="ii.vii.xx" next="ii.vii.xx.ii" id="ii.vii.xx.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xx.i-p1">The laws concerning the cities of refuge, ver. 1-6. The
appointment of those cities, ver. 7-9.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="54.47%" prev="ii.vii.xx.i" next="ii.vii.xxi" id="ii.vii.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p1">2. Appoint - The possessions being now divided among you,
reserve some of them for the use which I have commanded. Cities of
refuge - Designed to typify the relief which the gospel provides for
poor, penitent sinners, and their protection from the curse of the law
and the wrath of God, in our Lord Jesus, to whom believers fly for
refuge.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p2">3. Unwittingly - Hebrew. Through ignorance, or error, or
mistake, and without knowledge. The same thing twice repeated to cut off
all the expectations that wilful murderers might have of protection
here; God having declared, that such should be taken even from his
altar, that they might be killed. It is strange that any Christians
should make their sanctuaries give protection to such persons whom God
hath so expressly excepted from it! Avenger - The nearest kinsman, who
had right or power to demand, or take vengeance of the slaughter.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p3">4. The gate - Where the Judges used to sit. His cause -
Shall give them a true relation of the fact, and all its circumstances.
They shall take him - If they are satisfied in the relation he makes,
concerning the fact, otherwise it had been a vain thing to examine. Give
a place - Which they might well allow him, because God gave them the
city with a reservation for such persons.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p4">6. Stand - Which was the posture of the accused and
accusers. The congregation - The council appointed to judge of these
matters, not the council of the city of refuge, for they had examined
him before, ver. 4, but of the city to which he belonged, or in or nigh
which the fact was committed, as appears from <scripRef passage="Num. xxxv. 25" id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Num|35|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.35.25">Num. xxxv, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p5">7. And they appointed - Concerning these cities note,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p6">1. That they were all upon mountains, that
they might be seen at a great distance, and so direct those who fled
thither.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p7">2. That they were seated at convenient
distance one from another, for the benefit of the several tribes; for
Kedesh was in the north, Hebron in the south, and Shechem between
them.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p8">3. That they all belonged to the Levites;
partly that these causes might be more impartially examined, and justly
determined by them who are presumed best able to understand the law of
God, and most obliged to follow it and not to be biass'd by any
affection or corrupt interest, and partly, that their reputation with
the people, and their good counsels, might lay a restraint upon
revengeful persons, who might be inclined to follow the man- slayer
thither, and endeavour to kill him there. It was likewise an advantage
to the poor refugee, that when he might not go up to the house of the
Lord, yet he had the servants of God's house with him, to instruct him,
and pray for him, and help to make up the want of public ordinances.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p9">8. They assigned - Or, had assigned or given; for they
were given by Moses, <scripRef passage="Deut. iv. 41" id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Deut|4|41|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.4.41">Deut. iv, 41</scripRef>, &amp;c. or, they applied them to that use to which Moses
designed them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xx.ii-p10">9. The stranger - Not only proselytes, but others also;
because this was a matter of common right, that a distinction might be
made between casual man-slayers, and wilful murderers.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="54.52%" prev="ii.vii.xx.ii" next="ii.vii.xxi.i" id="ii.vii.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XXI" id="ii.vii.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xxi-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="54.52%" prev="ii.vii.xxi" next="ii.vii.xxi.ii" id="ii.vii.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.i-p1">The motion of the Levites, to have their cities
appointed, which is done, ver. 1-8. A catalogue of those cities, ver.
9-42. A testimony, that God had fulfilled his word, ver. 43-45.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="54.53%" prev="ii.vii.xxi.i" next="ii.vii.xxii" id="ii.vii.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p1">1. Then - When the whole land was distributed to the
several tribes, but not actually possessed by them; which was the proper
season for them to put in their claim. Fathers of the Levites-The
fathers of the Levites were Kohath, Gershom, and Merari, and the heads
of these were the chief persons now alive of these several families.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p2">2. The Lord commanded - Observe: the maintenance of
ministers is not an arbitrary thing, left purely to the good will of the
people. No: as the God of Israel commanded, that the Levites should be
provided for, so hath the Lord Jesus ordained, (and a perpetual
ordinance it is) that they who preach the gospel should live of the
gospel.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p3">3. The children of Israel gave - Probably they gave the
Levites promiscuously such cities as God commanded, and the lot
appropriated them to their several houses or families. Out of their
inheritance - That is, out of their several possessions; that the burden
might be equally divided; and, that the Levites being dispersed among
the several tribes, according to Jacob's prediction, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 7" id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Gen|49|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.7">Gen. xlix, 7</scripRef>, might more easily, and effectually teach the Israelites
God's law and judgments, which they were engaged to do, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxiii. 10" id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p3.2" parsed="|Deut|33|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.33.10">Deut. xxxiii, 10</scripRef>, and that the people might upon all occasions resort to
them, and inquire the meaning of the law at their mouths. And suburbs -
Not only the use, but the absolute dominion of them, as is manifest both
from ver. 11, 12, where a distinction is made between the city and
suburbs of Hebron, and the fields and villages thereof; (the former
given to the Levites, the latter to Caleb;) and from the return of these
cities in the Jubilee, unto the Levites as to their proper owners, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxv. 33, 34" id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p3.3" parsed="|Lev|25|33|25|34" osisRef="Bible:Lev.25.33-Lev.25.34">Lev. xxv, 33, 34.</scripRef></p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p4">4. Judah, Simeon, and Benjamin - Which three tribes were
nearest the temple, where their business lay. Thirteen cities - For
though the priests were now few enough for one city, yet respect was to
be had to their succeeding numbers; this division being made for all
future generations. And seeing the Levites might sell their houses until
the Jubilee, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxv. 33" id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Lev|25|33|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.25.33">Lev. xxv, 33</scripRef>, much more might they let them; and therefore it is probable
their cities were not long uninhabited, many being inclined to dwell
with them by virtue of relations contracted with them; or out of respect
to the service of God, and the good of their souls.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p5">5. Children of Kohath - Who were of Aaron's family.
Ephraim, Daniel, and Manesseh - Which tribes are nearest to the three
former, and so the Kohathites are placed next to their brethren the
Aaronites. Ten cities - Fewer than they gave out of the three former
tribes, because their inheritance was less than the former.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p6">9. Judah and Simeon - These are mentioned together,
because the cities of Simeon lay within Judah's portion.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p7">10. Families - That is, of the family, the plural number
for the singular, which is not unusual.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p8">12. The fields and villages - That is, all beyond the two
thousand cubits expressed, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxv. 5" id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Num|35|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.35.5">Num. xxxv, 5</scripRef>. This is here mentioned, not as his peculiar case, but as
one eminent instance, to shew, that it was so in all the rest of the
cities here named; that the fields and villages thereof still belonged
to the several tribes from whom the cities and their suburbs were taken;
and to make the rest of the Israelites more cheerfully resign part of
their possessions to the Levites, because even Caleb did so, though his
possession had been long before promised, and now actually given to him
by God's special command, as a mark of honour and compensation for his
long and faithful service.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p9">16. And Ain - Ain and Gibeon, and some others here named
are not named, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. vi. 59" id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|1Chr|6|59|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.6.59">1 Chron. vi, 59</scripRef>. Either they were destroyed in some of those invasions
wherewith their land was grievously wasted before that time; or they
appear there under other names.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p10">20. Which remained - Over and above those who were
priests.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p11">25. Half the tribe - Namely, that half which dwelt in
Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p12">41. Forty eight cities - Why hath this tribe, which was
the least of all, more cities than any of them? First, it doth not
appear that they had more: for though all the cities of the Levites be
expressed, it is not so with the other tribes, but divers of their
cities are omitted. Secondly, the Levites were confined to their cities
and suburbs; the rest had large territories belonging to their cities,
which also so they were in a capacity of improving, which the Levites
were not; so that one of their cities might be more considerable than
divers of the Levites. Thirdly, God, was pleased to deal liberally with
his ministers, to put honour on those whom he foresaw many would be
prone to despise; and, that being free from outward distractions, they
might more entirely and fervently devote themselves to the service of
God.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p13">43. All the land - He gave them the right to all, and the
actual possession of the greatest part of it, and power to possess the
rest, as soon as it was needful for them, which was when their numbers
were increased, and the absolute dominion of all the people remaining in
it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p14">44. Gave them rest - Namely, all the days of Joshua; for
afterwards it was otherwise with them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p15">45. All came to pass - Such an acknowledgment as this,
here subscribed by Joshua, in the name of all Israel, we afterward find
made by Solomon; and all Israel did in effect say amen to it, <scripRef passage="1 Kings viii. 56" id="ii.vii.xxi.ii-p15.1" parsed="|1Kgs|8|56|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.8.56">1 Kings viii, 56</scripRef>. The inviolable truth of God's promise, and the performance
of it to the uttermost, is what all believers in Christ have been always
ready to bear their testimony to. And if in any thing it has seemed to
come short, they have been as ready to take all the blame to
themselves.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="54.62%" prev="ii.vii.xxi.ii" next="ii.vii.xxii.i" id="ii.vii.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XXII" id="ii.vii.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xxii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="54.62%" prev="ii.vii.xxii" next="ii.vii.xxii.ii" id="ii.vii.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.i-p1">Joshua's dismission of the two tribes and an half, and
their return to their own country, ver. 1-9. The altar they built on
that side of Jordan, which offended the other tribes, ver. 10-20. Their
apology, with which the rest were satisfied, ver. 21-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXII" progress="54.63%" prev="ii.vii.xxii.i" next="ii.vii.xxiii" id="ii.vii.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p1">4. Your tents - That is, to your settled habitations.
Tho' their affections to their families could not but make them very
desirous to return, yet like good soldiers, they would not move 'till
they had orders from their general. So, tho' we desire to be at home
with Christ ever so much, yet we must stay here till our warfare is
accomplished, wait for a due discharge, and not anticipate the time of
our removal.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p2">5. Take heed - Watch over yourselves and all your
actions. Commandment and law - Two words expressing the same thing, the
law of commandments delivered by Moses. All your heart and soul - With
the whole strength of your minds, and wills, and affections.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p3">8. With your brethren -- that is, with them who stayed
beyond Jordan for the defense of their land, and wives, and children,
who therefore were to have a share, though not an equal share with
these. But for them, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxx. 24" id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|1Sam|30|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.30.24">1 Sam. xxx, 24</scripRef>, their share was equal, because their danger was equal.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p4">10. Built an altar - About that time when they came to
them, they designed it, and as soon as they were got over Jordan, which
was in a very little time, they effected and perfected it. They built
it, no doubt, on their own side of the water: for how could they build
on other men's land, without their consent? And it is said, in the
following verse, to be over against the land of Jordan. Nor would there
have been cause to suspect that it was designed for sacrifice, if they
had not built it among themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p5">11. At the passage - Where they passed over Jordan,
either at their first entrance into Canaan, or afterwards, and
usually.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p6">12. The children of Israel - Not in their own persons,
not by their elders, who used to transact all affairs of this kind in
the name of all the people. Against them - As apostates from God,
according to God's command in that case, <scripRef passage="Deut. xiii. 13" id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Deut|13|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.13.13">Deut. xiii, 13</scripRef>. &amp;c.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p7">16. The congregation - Who do and are resolved to cleave
unto that God from whom you have revolted. What trespass - How heinous a
crime is this! This day - That is, so soon after God hath obliged you by
such wonderful favours, and when God is now conducting you home to reap
the fruits of all your pains and hazards. Rebel - With a design to rebel
against God, and against his express command of worshipping him at one
only altar.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p8">17. Of Peor - That is, of our worshipping of Baal-peor, <scripRef passage="Num. xxv. 3" id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Num|25|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.25.3">Num. xxv, 3</scripRef>. Probably this is mentioned the rather, because Phinehas,
the first commissioner in this treaty, had signalized himself in that
matter: and because they were now at or near the very place, where that
iniquity was committed. Are not cleansed - For though God had pardoned
it, as to the national punishment of it, <scripRef passage="Num. xxv. 11" id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p8.2" parsed="|Num|25|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.25.11">Num. xxv, 11</scripRef>, yet they were not yet throughly purged from it; partly
because the shame and blot of that odious practice was not yet wiped
off: and partly, because some of that corrupt leaven still remained
among them, and though smothered for a time, yet was ready to break
forth upon all occasions, See chap. xxiv, 33. And God also took notice
of these idolatrous inclinations in particular persons, and found out
ways to punish them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p9">18. Tomorrow - That is, suddenly, as that word is often
used. Congregation - With you for doing so, and with us for suffering,
or not punishing it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p10">19. Be unclean - If you apprehend it to be so for want of
the tabernacle and altar there; as the following words imply: if you now
repent of your former choice in preferring the worldly commodities of
that country before the advantage of God's presence, and more frequent
opportunities of his service. Among us - We will readily resign part of
our possessions to you for the prevention of this sin and mischief.
Against us - For all the tribes were united in one body politick, and
made one commonwealth, and one church; and each tribe was subject to the
laws and commands of the whole society, and of the chief ruler or rulers
thereof; so its disobedience to their just commands was properly
rebellion against them.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p11">20. Of Zerah - That is, one of his posterity. Not alone -
But brought destruction upon his whole family, and part of our forces
sent against Ai.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p12">22. The Lord - That Jehovah, whom we no less than you
acknowledge and adore as the God of gods, infinitely superior to all
that are called gods. The multiplying of his titles, and the repetition
of these words, shew their zeal and earnestness in this matter. He
knoweth - To him we appeal who knoweth all things, and the truth of what
we are now saying. Not only our present words, but our future and
constant course shall satisfy all Israel of our perseverance in the true
religion. In rebellion - If this have been done by us with such design,
or in such a manner. Save us not - Thou, O Lord, to whom we have
appealed, and without whom we cannot be saved and preserved, save us not
from any of our enemies, nor from the sword of our brethren. It is a
sudden apostrophe to God, usual in such vehement speeches.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p13">23. Require it - That is, call us to an account and
punish us for it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p14">24. With the Lord - You have no relation to him, nor
interest in him, or his worship.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p15">25. A border - To shut you out of the land of promise,
and consequently from the covenant made between God and our fathers. No
part - Nothing to do with him; no right to serve him or expect favour
from him. Cease from fearing the Lord - For they that are cut off from
public ordinances, usually by degrees lose all religion. It is true, the
form and profession of godliness, may be kept without the life and power
of it. But the life and power will not long be kept, without the form
and profession of it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p16">27. Before him - That we and ours may have and hold our
privilege of serving and worshiping God, not upon this altar, but in the
place of God's presence, in your tabernacle, and upon your altar.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p17">28. The pattern - An exact representation and
resemblance. A witness - That we both serve one God, and approve and
make use of one and the same altar.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p18">30. Pleased them - They were fully satisfied with this
answer.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p19">31. Is among us - By his gracious presence, and
preventing goodness, in keeping you from so great an offense, and all of
us from those calamities that would have followed it. Hand of the Lord -
That is, from the wroth and dreadful judgments of God, by avoiding that
sin which would have involved both you and us in a most bloody war; you
have delivered us from the evils we feared. He that prevents an
approaching disease or mischief, doth as truly deliver a man from it, as
he that cures or removes it after it hath been inflicted.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p20">33. Destroy the land - As they were by the law of God
obliged to do, if they had been guilty and persisted therein; as
afterwards they did the tribe of Benjamin for the same reason.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxii.ii-p21">34. The altar Ed - That is, a witness: a witness of the
relation they stood in to God and Israel, and of their concurrence with
the other tribes in the common faith, that Jehovah he is God. It was a
witness to posterity, of their care to transmit their religion pure and
entire; and would be a witness against them, if ever they should turn
from following the Lord their God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="54.75%" prev="ii.vii.xxii.ii" next="ii.vii.xxiii.i" id="ii.vii.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XXIII" id="ii.vii.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xxiii-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="54.75%" prev="ii.vii.xxiii" next="ii.vii.xxiii.ii" id="ii.vii.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.i-p1">Joshua reminds the people, assembled for that purpose, of
what God had done, and what he would do for them, ver. 1-5. Exhorts them
resolutely to persevere in their duty to God, ver. 6- 8. which he
enforces by former benefits, and by promises, ver. 9- 11. and by
threatnings, ver. 12-16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="54.76%" prev="ii.vii.xxiii.i" next="ii.vii.xxiv" id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p1">1. A long time - About fourteen years after it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p2">2. Joshua called - Either to his own city, or rather to
Shiloh, the usual place of such assemblies, where his words being
uttered before the Lord, were likely to have the more effect upon them.
All Israel - Not all the people in their own persons, but in their
representatives, by their elders, heads, Judges and officers. Probably
he took the opportunity, of one of the three great feasts. You will not
have me long to preach to you; therefore observe what I say, and lay it
up for the time to come.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p3">3. Because of you - For your good, that you might gain by
their losses.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p4">4. That remain - Not yet conquered. An inheritance - You
shall certainly subdue them, and inherit their hand, as you have done
the rest, if you be not wanting to yourselves. All the nations - That
is, with the land of those nations; the people put for their land, as we
have seen before; and as sometimes on the contrary, the land is put for
the people. The great sea - Where the Philistines, your most formidable
adversaries yet survive; but them also and their land I have given to
you, and you shall undoubtedly destroy them, if you will proceed
vigourously in your work.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p5">6. Very courageous - For it will require great courage
and resolution to execute all the commands of Moses, and particularly,
that of expelling and destroying the residue of the Canaanites. The
right hand or the left - That is, in one kind or other, by adding to the
law, or diminishing from it.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p6">7. Come not - That is, avoid all familiar converse and
contracts, but especially marriages with them. Name their gods - To wit,
unnecessarily and familiarly, lest the mention of them breed discourse
about them, and so by degrees bring to the approbation and worship of
them. Nor cause - Nor require nor compel the Gentiles to swear by them,
as they used to do; especially in leagues and contracts. It is pity,
that among Christians, the name of the Heathen God's are so commonly
used, especially in poems. Let those names which have been set up in
rivalship with God, be forever loathed and lost. Nor bow - Neither give
them any inward reverence, or outward adoration. Here is an observable
gradation, whereby he shews what notable progress sin usually makes, and
what need there is to look to the beginnings of it, forasmuch as a civil
and common conversation with their persons was likely to bring them, and
indeed did actually bring them, by insensible steps, to the worship of
their gods. So it is no wonder, if some things not simply and in
themselves evil, be forbidden by God, as here the naming of their gods
is, because they are occasions and introductions to evil.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p7">8. Cleave to the Lord - By constant obedience, entire
affection, faithful service and worship of him alone. To this day - To
wit, since you came in to Canaan; since which time the body of the
people (for of them he speaks, not of every particular person) had
behaved themselves much better than they did in the wilderness, and had
not been guilty of any gross and general apostacy from God, or rebellion
against him.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p8">9. No man - To wit, whom you have invaded; otherwise some
of those people did yet remain unconquered.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p9">10. He fighteth - Impute not this therefore to your own
valour, as you will be apt to do, but to God's gracious and powerful
assistance.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p10">11. Take heed - Now it requires more watchfulness and
diligence than it did in the wilderness, because your temptations are
now stronger; from the examples and insinuations of your bad neighbours,
the remainders of this wicked people; and from your own peace and
prosperity: and the pride, security, forgetfulness of God, and luxury,
which usually attend that condition.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p11">12. Go back - From God, and from his worship and
service.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p12">13. Traps to you - By your converse with them, you will
be drawn by degrees into their errors, and impieties, and brutish lusts.
Thorns in your eyes - When they have seduced, and thereby weakened you,
then they will molest and vex you, no less than a severe scourge doth a
man's sides which are lashed by it, or than a small thorn doth the eye
when it is got within it. Till ye perish - They shall so persecute you,
and fight against, you with such success, that you shall be forced to
quit your own land, and wander you know not whither; which must needs be
very terrible to them to think of, when they compared this present ease,
and plenty and safety, with the pains, and weariness, and hazards, and
wants of their former wanderings.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p13">14. Of all the earth - That is, of all flesh, or of all
men; the way which all men go; I am about to die, as all men must. To
die is, to go a journey, a journey to our long home. And Joshua himself,
tho' he could so ill be spared, cannot be exempted from this common lot.
He takes notice of it, that they might look on these as his dying words,
and regard them accordingly. Ye know - That is, you know assuredly; your
own experience puts it out of all question.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p14">15. Evil things - The accomplishment of God's promise is
a pledge that he will also fulfil his threatnings; both of them
depending upon the same ground, the faithfulness of God.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiii.ii-p15">16. It will aggravate their perdition, that the land from
which they shall perish is a good land, and a land which God himself had
given them: and which therefore he would have secured to them, if they
had not thrown themselves out of it. "Thus the goodness of the heavenly
Canaan, says Mr. Henry, and the free and sure grant God has made of it,
will aggravate the misery of those that shall forever be shut out and
perish from it. Nothing will make them see how wretched they are, so
much as to see, how happy they might have been." Might have been! What
on the supposition of absolute decrees? How happy might a person not
elected have been? And if he was elected, how could he be wretched for
ever? What art of man can reconcile these things? Again, shall any of
the elect perish forever? or has God made to any others, a free and
sure grant of the heavenly Canaan? If not, how can the misery of those
that perish be aggravated, by a free and sure grant which they never had
any share in?</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="54.87%" prev="ii.vii.xxiii.ii" next="ii.vii.xxiv.i" id="ii.vii.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Joshua XXIV" id="ii.vii.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|Josh|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.vii.xxiv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIV" progress="54.87%" prev="ii.vii.xxiv" next="ii.vii.xxiv.ii" id="ii.vii.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.i-p1">Joshua assembling the people, recounts what great things
God had done for them, ver. 1-13. Exhorts them to serve God, which they
engage to do, ver. 14-28. His age, death, and burial, ver. 29-31. The
burying of Joseph's bones, ver. 32. The death and burial of Eleazar,
ver. 33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIV" progress="54.87%" prev="ii.vii.xxiv.i" next="ii.viii" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p1">1. All Israel - Namely, their representatives. Shechem -
To the city of Shechem, a place convenient for the purpose, not only
because it was a Levitical city, and a city of refuge, and a place near
Joshua's city, but especially for the two main ends for which he
summoned them thither.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p2">1. For the solemn burial of the bones of
Joseph, and the rest of the patriarchs, for which this place was
designed.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p3">2. For the solemn renewing of their
covenant with God; which in this place was first made between God and
Abraham, <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 6, 7" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Gen|12|6|12|7" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.6-Gen.12.7">Gen. xii, 6, 7</scripRef>, and afterwards renewed by the Israelites at their first
entrance into the land of Canaan, between the two mountains of Ebal and
Gerizzim, chap. viii, 30, &amp;c. which were very near Shechem: and
therefore this place was most proper, both to remind them of their
former obligations to God, and to engage them to a farther ratification
of them. Before God - As in God's presence, to hear what Joshua was to
speak to them in God's name, and to receive God's commands from his
mouth. He had taken a solemn farewell before: but as God renewed his
strength, he desired to improve it for their good. We must never think
our work for God done, 'till our life is done.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p4">2. The people - To the elders, by whom it was to be
imparted to all the rest, and to as many of the people as came thither.
He spake to them in God's name, and as from him, in the language of a
prophet, Thus saith the Lord. Jehovah, the great God, and the God of
Israel, whom you are peculiarly engaged to hear. The flood - Or, the
river, namely, Euphrates, so called by way of eminency. They served -
That is, Both Abraham and Nahor were no less idolaters than the rest of
mankind. This is said to prevent their vain boasting in their worthy
ancestors, and to assure them that whatsoever good was in, or had been
done by their progenitors, was wholly from God's free grace, and not for
their own merit or righteousness.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p5">3. I took - I snatched him out of that idolatrous place,
and took him into acquaintance and covenant with myself, which was the
highest honour and happiness he was capable of. And led - That is I
brought him after his father's death into Canaan, <scripRef passage="Gen. xii. 1" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|12|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.12.1">Gen. xii, 1</scripRef>, and I conducted and preserved him in all his travels
through the several parts of Canaan. And multiplied - That is, gave him
a numerous posterity, not only by Hagar and Keturah, but even by Sarah
and by Isaac. Gave Isaac - By my special power and grace to be heir of
my covenant, and all my promises, and the seed in or by which all the
nations were to be blessed.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p6">4. Mount Seir - That he might leave Canaan entire to his
brother Jacob and his posterity, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxvi. 7, 8" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Gen|36|7|36|8" osisRef="Bible:Gen.36.7-Gen.36.8">Gen. xxxvi, 7, 8</scripRef>. Into Egypt - Where they long lived in grievous bondage;
which God having delivered us from, I shall now pass it over. 7. Your
eyes - He speaketh this to the elders, ver. 1, who were so, not only by
power and dignity, but many of them by age; and there being now not
sixty years past since those Egyptian plagues, it is very probable that
a considerable number of those present, had seen those things in Egypt,
and being not twenty years old, were exempted from that dreadful
sentence passed upon all who were older, <scripRef passage="Num. xiv. 29" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Num|14|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.14.29">Num. xiv, 29</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p7">9. Balak warred - Balak warred, tho' not by open force,
yet by crafty counsel and warlike stratagems, by wicked devices.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p8">10. Unto Balaam - Who hereby appears to have desired of
God leave to curse Israel; and therefore it is not strange, that God who
permitted him simply to go, was highly angry with him for going with so
wicked an intent, <scripRef passage="Num. xxii. 20, 22, 32" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Num|22|20|0|0;|Num|22|22|0|0;|Num|22|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.22.20 Bible:Num.22.22 Bible:Num.22.32">Num. xxii, 20, 22, 32</scripRef>. Delivered you - That is, from Balak's malicious design
against you.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p9">11. Deliver them - Namely, successively; for in these few
words he seems to comprise all their wars, which being so fresh in their
memory, he thought it needless particularly to mention.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p10">12. Sent the hornet - When they were actually engaged in
battle with the Canaanites. These dreadful swarms which first appeared
in their war with Sihon and Og, tormented them with their stings and
terrified them with their noise, so that they became an easy prey to
Israel. God had promised to do this for them, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiii. 27, 28" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Exod|23|27|23|28" osisRef="Bible:Exod.23.27-Exod.23.28">Exod. xxiii, 27, 28</scripRef>, and here Joshua observes the fulfilling the promise.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p11">14. The gods - Whereby it appears, that although Joshua
had doubtless prevented and purged out all public idolatry, yet there
were some of them who practiced it in their private houses and
retirements. Your fathers - Terah, and Nahor, and Abraham, as ver. 2,
and other of your ancestors. In Egypt - See <scripRef passage="Ezek xxiii. 3, 8, 19, 21, 27" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Ezek|23|3|0|0;|Ezek|23|8|0|0;|Ezek|23|19|0|0;|Ezek|23|21|0|0;|Ezek|23|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.23.3 Bible:Ezek.23.8 Bible:Ezek.23.19 Bible:Ezek.23.21 Bible:Ezek.23.27">Ezek xxiii, 3, 8, 19, 21, 27</scripRef>. Under these particulars, no doubt he comprehends all other
false gods, which were served by the nations amongst whom they were, but
only mentions these, as the idols which they were in more danger of
worshipping than those in Canaan; partly because those of Canaan had
been now lately and palpably disgraced by their inability to preserve
their worshippers from total ruin; and partly, because the other idols
came recommended to them by the venerable name of antiquity, and the
custom of their forefathers.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p12">15. Seem evil - Unjust, unreasonable or inconvenient.
Choose ye - Not that he leaves them to their liberty, whether they would
serve God or idols; for Joshua had no such power himself, nor could give
it to any other; and both he and they were obliged by the law of Moses,
to give their worship to God only, and to forbear all idolatry in
themselves, and severely to punish it in others; but it is a powerful
insinuation, whereby he both implies, that the worship of God is so
highly reasonable, necessary and beneficial; and the service of idols so
absurd, and vain, and pernicious, that if it were left free for all men
to take their choice, every man in his right wits must needs chuse the
service of God, before that of idols; and provokes them to bind
themselves faster to God by their own choice. He will - But know this,
if you should all be so base and brutish, as to prefer senseless and
impotent idols, before the true and living God, it is my firm purpose,
that I will, and my children, and servants (as far as I can influence
them) shall be constant and faithful to the Lord. And that, whatever
others do. They that resolve to serve God, must not start at being
singular in it. They that are bound for heaven must be willing to swim
against the stream, and must do, not as most do, but as the best do.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p13">19. Ye cannot - He speaks not of an absolute
impossibility, (for then both his resolution to serve God himself, and
his exhortation to them had been vain) but of a moral impossibility, or
a very great difficulty, which he alledgeth not to discourage them from
God's service, but to make them more considerate in obliging themselves;
and more resolved in answering their obligations. The meaning is, God's
service is not, as you seem to fancy, a slight and easy thing, but it is
a work of great difficulty, and requires great care, and courage and
resolution; and when I consider the infinite purity of God, that he will
not be mocked or abused; and withal your proneness to superstition and
idolatry, even during the life of Moses, and in some of you, while I
live, and while the obligations which God had laid upon you in this
land, are fresh in remembrance; I cannot but fear that after my decease
you will think the service of God burdensome, and therefore will cast it
off and revolt from him, if you do not carefully avoid all occasions of
idolatry. A jealous God - In the Hebrew, He is the holy Gods, holy
Father, holy Son, holy Spirit. He will not endure a partner in his
worship; you can not serve him and idols together. Will not forgive - If
you who own yourselves his people and servants, shall wilfully
transgress his laws, he will not let this go unpunished in you, as he
doth in other nations; therefore consider what you do, when you take the
Lord for your God; weigh your advantages and inconveniences together;
for as if you be sincere and faithful in God's service, you will have
admirable benefits by it; so if you be false to your professions, and
forsake him whom you have so solemnly avouched to be your God, he will
deal more severely with you than with any people in the world.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p14">20. Will turn - That is, he will alter his course and the
manner of his dealing with you, and will be as severe as ever he was
kind and gracious. He will repent of his former kindnesses, and his
goodness abused will be turned into fury.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p15">21. The Lord - Namely, him only, and not strange
gods.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p16">22. Against yourselves - This solemn profession will be a
swift witness against you, if hereafter you apostatize from God.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p17">23. Strange gods - Those idols which you either brought
out of Egypt, or have taken in Canaan, which some of you keep contrary
to God's command, whether for the preciousness of the matter, or rather
for some secret inclination to superstition and idolatry.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p18">25. A statute - He set or established that covenant with
them, that is, the people, for a statute or an ordinance, to bind
themselves and their posterity unto God forever.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p19">26. These words - That is, this covenant or agreement of
the people with the Lord. In the book - That is, in the volume which was
kept in the ark, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxi. 9, 26" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Deut|31|9|0|0;|Deut|31|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.31.9 Bible:Deut.31.26">Deut. xxxi, 9, 26</scripRef>, whence it was taken and put into this book of Joshua: this
he did for the perpetual remembrance of this great and solemn action, to
lay the greater obligation upon the people to be true to their
engagement; and as a witness for God, against the people, if afterward
he punished them for their defection from God, to whom they had so
solemnly and freely obliged themselves. Set it up - As a witness and
monument of this great transaction, according to the custom of those
ancient times. Possibly this agreement was written upon this stone, as
was then usual. By the sanctuary - That is, near the place where the ark
and tabernacle then were; for tho' they were forbidden to plant a grove
of trees near unto the altar, as the Gentiles did, yet they might for a
time set up an altar, or the ark, near a great tree which had been
planted there before.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p20">27. It hath heard - It shall be as sure a witness against
you, as if it had heard. This is a common figure, whereby the sense of
hearing is often ascribed to the heavens and the earth, and other
senseless creatures.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p21">32. The bones of Joseph - Joseph died two hundred years
before in Egypt, but gave commandment concerning his bones, that they
should not rest in a grave, 'till Israel rested in the land of promise.
Now therefore they were deposited in that piece of ground, which his
father gave him near Shechem. One reason why Joshua called all Israel to
Shechem, might be to attend Joseph's bones to the grave. So that he now
delivered as it were both Joseph's funeral sermon, and his own farewell
sermon. And if it was in the last year of his life, the occasion might
well remind him, of his own death now at hand. For he was just of the
same age with his illustrious ancestor, who died being one hundred and
ten years old, <scripRef passage="Gen. i. 26" id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p21.1" parsed="|Gen|1|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.1.26">Gen. i, 26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.vii.xxiv.ii-p22">33. Given him - By special favour, and for his better
conveniency in attending upon the ark, which then was, and for a long
time was to be in Shiloh, near this place: whereas the cities which were
given to the priests, were in Judah. Benjamin, and Simeon, which were
remote from Shiloh, tho' near the place where the ark was to have its
settled abode, namely, at Jerusalem. It is probable Eleazar died about
the same time with Joshua, as Aaron did in the same year with Moses.
While Joshua lived, religion was kept up, under his care and influence,
but after he and his contemporaries were gone, it swiftly went to decay.
How well is it for the gospel church, that Christ, our Joshua, is still
with it by his Spirit, and will be always, even to the end of the
world?</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE BOOK OF JUDGES" progress="55.08%" prev="ii.vii.xxiv.ii" next="ii.viii.i" id="ii.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judg" id="ii.viii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.viii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE BOOK OF JUDGES</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Judges" progress="55.08%" prev="ii.viii" next="ii.viii.ii" id="ii.viii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.i-p1">This book contains the history of the Israelites under the
Judges, which lasted two hundred and ninety nine years: under Othniel,
forty, under Ehud, eighty, under Barak, forty, under Gideon, forty,
under Abimelek, three, under Tola, twenty-three, under Jair, twenty-two,
under Jephtha, six, under Ibzan, seven, under Elon, ten, under Abdon,
eight, under Samson, twenty. As for the years of their servitude, they
coincide with the years of some or other of the Judges. In the five last
chapters we have an account of some memorable events, which happened in
the days when the Judges ruled. As to the state of Israel during this
period,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.viii.i-p2">1. They were miserably corrupted, and
miserably oppressed. Yet we may hope, the tabernacle service was kept
up, and that many attended it.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.viii.i-p3">2. It seems, each tribe had its government
within itself, and acted separately, without any common head. This
occasioned many differences among themselves.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.viii.i-p4">3. The government of the Judges was not
constant but occasional. By their judging Israel is meant chiefly, their
avenging Israel of their enemies, and purging them from their
idolatries.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.viii.i-p5">4. During the government of the Judges, God
was in an especial manner the king of Israel. It is not improbably
supposed, that the prophet Samuel was the penman of this book.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="55.10%" prev="ii.viii.i" next="ii.viii.ii.i" id="ii.viii.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges I" id="ii.viii.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="55.10%" prev="ii.viii.ii" next="ii.viii.ii.ii" id="ii.viii.ii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.ii.i-p1">The conquests made by Judah and Simeon, ver. 1-20.
Benjamin failed, ver. 21. The house of Joseph took Bethel, ver. 22-26.
But Manasseh did not drive out the Canaanites, ver. 27, 28. Nor Ephraim,
ver. 29. Nor Zebulun, ver. 30. Nor Asher, ver. 31, 32. Nor Naphtali,
ver. 33. Nor Daniel, ver. 34-36.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="55.11%" prev="ii.viii.ii.i" next="ii.viii.iii" id="ii.viii.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p1">1. After the death - Not long after it; for Othniel, the
first judge, lived in Joshua's time. Asked the Lord - Being assembled
together at Shiloh, they inquired of the high-priest by the Urim and the
Thummim. Against the Canaanites first - Finding their people multiply
exceedingly, and consequently the necessity of enlarging their quarters,
they renew the war. They do not inquire who shall be captain general to
all the tribes; but what tribe shall first undertake the expedition,
that by their success the other tribes may be encouraged to make the
like attempt upon the Canaanites in their several lots.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p2">2. Judah - The tribe of Judah is chosen for the first
enterprise, because they were both most populous, and so most needing
enlargement; and withal most valiant, and therefore most likely to
succeed: for God chooseth fit means for the work which he designs.
Moreover the Canaanites were numerous and strong in those parts, and
therefore to be suppressed, before they grew too strong for them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p3">3. To Simeon - As nearest to him both by relation, being
his brother by both parents, and by habitation. The Canaanites -
Specially so called, because they are distinguished from the Perizzites,
ver. 4.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p4">4. In Bezek - Not in the city, for that was not yet
taken, ver. 5, but in the territory of it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p5">5. Adoni-bezek - The Lord or king of Bezek; as his name
signifies. In Bezek - Whither he fled when he lost the field. Against
him - That is, against the city wherein he had encamped himself, and the
rest of his army.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p6">6. Great toes - And this they did, either by the
direction of God, or upon notice of his former tyranny and cruelty.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p7">7. Threescore and ten - Which is not strange in those
times and places. For it is well known, that anciently each ruler of a
city, or great town, was called a king, and had kingly power in that
place; and many such kings we meet with in Canaan: and it is probable,
that some years before, kings were more numerous there, 'till the
greater devoured many of the less. Under my table - An act of barbarous
inhumanity thus to insult over the miserable, joined with abominable
luxury.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p8">8. And took - Yet some of the inhabitants retired into
the castle, and held out there 'till David's time.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p9">10. Judah went - Under the conduct of Caleb, as is
recorded, ver. 14, &amp;c., for that relation, and this, are doubtless
one and the same expedition, and it is mentioned there by
anticipation.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p10">16. Moses's father-in-law - That is, of Jethro, so called
from the people whom he descended, <scripRef passage="Num. xxiv. 21, 22" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Num|24|21|24|22" osisRef="Bible:Num.24.21-Num.24.22">Num. xxiv, 21, 22</scripRef>. And, whatsoever he did, it is evident, that his posterity
came into Canaan with the Israelites, and were there seated with them,
see chap. iv, 11, 17; v, 24; <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xv. 6" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p10.2" parsed="|1Sam|15|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.15.6">1 Sam. xv, 6</scripRef>; <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ii. 1-54" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p10.3" parsed="|1Chr|2|1|2|54" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.2.1-1Chr.2.54">1 Chron. ii, 1-54</scripRef>, 55. City of palm-trees - That is, from Jericho, so called, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxiv. 3" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p10.4" parsed="|Deut|34|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.34.3">Deut. xxxiv, 3</scripRef>, not the city which was destroyed, but the territory
belonging to it, where it seems they were seated, in a most pleasant,
and fruitful, and safe place, according to the promise made by Moses to
their father, <scripRef passage="Num. x. 29-32" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p10.5" parsed="|Num|10|29|10|32" osisRef="Bible:Num.10.29-Num.10.32">Num. x,
29-32</scripRef>, and whence they might remove, either to avoid the
neighbouring Canaanites; or out of love to the children of Judah. South
of Arad - In the southern part of the land of Canaan, where Arad was, <scripRef passage="Num. xxi. 1" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p10.6" parsed="|Num|21|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.21.1">Num. xxi, 1</scripRef>. They went - That is some of them, for others of them dwelt
in a contrary quarter, in the most northern part of the land. Among the
people - Hebrew. that people, namely, those children of Judah that lived
there.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p11">17. Judah went with Simeon - According to his promise,
ver. 3, and the laws of justice and gratitude. Hormah - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p12">1. The same place so called, <scripRef passage="Num. xxi. 3" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Num|21|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.21.3">Num. xxi, 3</scripRef>, and so what was there vowed, is here executed: or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p13">2. Some other place called by the same name
upon the like occasion, which was frequent among the Hebrew. This seems
more probable.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p14">18. Judah took - It is only said, they took the cities,
and probably contented themselves with making them tributary; but it is
not said that they slew the people, as they ought to have done; and as
it is said of the other cities here. And the people being thus spared,
did by God's just judgment recover their strength, and expel the Jews
out of their cities. It is farther observable, that Ekron here taken,
was one of Dan's cities, ver. 43, and it was taken here by Judah and
Simeon, partly out of love for their brother Daniel, and partly to
secure their new conquests, and other adjoining territories, from such
potent neighbours.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p15">19. Could not drive - Because of their unbelief, whereby
they distrusted God's power to destroy those who had chariots of iron,
and so gave way to their own fear and sloth, whereby God was provoked to
withdraw his helping hand.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p16">22. House of Joseph - That is, the tribe of Ephraim.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p17">24. The entrance - On which side it is weakest, that we
might best invade and take it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p18">25. His family - Together with his estate, as the
following verse manifests.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p19">26. The Hittites - Where the Hittites seated themselves
after they were driven out of Canaan, which seems to be northward from
Canaan, and near upon it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p20">27. Manasseh - That is, that half of this tribe which
dwelt in Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p21">29. In Gezer - Which they possessed 'till Solomon's time,
<scripRef passage="1 Kings ix. 16" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p21.1" parsed="|1Kgs|9|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.9.16">1 Kings ix, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p22">34. The valley - That is, into the plain country; which
was the occasion of that expedition for the getting new quarters, of
which we read ver. 47, 48 and chap. xviii, 1-31.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p23">35. House of Joseph - That is, of the Ephraimites, who
helped their brethren the Danites against the Amorites.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p24">36. Akrabbim - Which was in the southern part of Canaan, <scripRef passage="Josh. xv. 2, 3" id="ii.viii.ii.ii-p24.1" parsed="|Josh|15|2|15|3" osisRef="Bible:Josh.15.2-Josh.15.3">Josh. xv, 2, 3</scripRef> , from whence it went up towards the north. This is added to
shew the great power and large extent of this people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="55.21%" prev="ii.viii.ii.ii" next="ii.viii.iii.i" id="ii.viii.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges II" id="ii.viii.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="55.21%" prev="ii.viii.iii" next="ii.viii.iii.ii" id="ii.viii.iii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.iii.i-p1">An angel reproves Israel, who bewail their sins, ver.
1-5. They served God during the life of Joshua and his contemporaries,
ver. 4-9. Their frequent revolts to idolatry, ver. 10-19. God stops
their success, ver. 20-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="55.21%" prev="ii.viii.iii.i" next="ii.viii.iv" id="ii.viii.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p1">1. The angel - Christ the angel of the covenant, often
called the angel of the Lord, to whom the conduct of Israel out of Egypt
into Canaan, is frequently ascribed. He alone could speak the following
words in his own name and person; whereas created angels and prophets
universally usher in their message with, Thus saith the Lord, or some
equivalent expression. And this angel having assumed the shape of a man,
it is not strange that he imitates the motion of a man, and comes as it
were from Gilgal to the place where now they were: by which motion he
signified, that he was the person that brought them to Gilgal, the first
place where they rested in Canaan, and there protected them so long, and
from thence went with them to battle, and gave them success. Bochim - A
place so called by anticipation; it seems to be no other than Shiloh,
where it is probable, the people were met together upon some solemn
festival. I said - That is, I promised upon condition of your keeping
covenant with me.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p2">2. Done this - That is, disobeyed these express
commands.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p3">3. I said - With myself, I have now taken up this
peremptory resolution.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p4">4. Wept - Some of them from a true sense of their sins;
others from a just apprehension of their approaching misery.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p5">5. Bochim - That is, Weepers. They sacrificed - For the
expiation of their sins, by which they had provoked God to this
resolution.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p6">6. Let the people go - When he had distributed their
inheritances, and dismissed them severally to take possession of them.
This was done before this time, whilst Joshua lived; but is now repeated
to discover the time, and occasion of the peoples defection from God,
and of God's desertion of them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p7">10. Knew not - Which had no experimental, nor serious and
affectionate knowledge of God, or of his works.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p8">11. In the sight - Which notes the heinousness and
impudence of their sins, above other peoples; because God's presence was
with them, and his eye upon them in a peculiar manner, which also they
were not ignorant of, and therefore were guilty of more contempt of God
than other people. Baalim - False gods. He useth the plural number,
because the gods of the Canaanites, and adjoining nations, which Israel
worshipped, were most of them called by the name of Baal.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p9">13. Baal and Ashtaroth - That is, the sun and moon, whom
many Heathens worshipped, tho' under divers names; and so they ran into
that error which God had so expressly warned them against, <scripRef passage="Deut. iv. 19" id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Deut|4|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.4.19">Deut. iv, 19</scripRef>. Baalim signifies lords, and Ashtaroth, blessed ones,
he-gods and she-gods. When they forsook Jehovah, they had gods many and
lords many, as a luxuriant fancy pleased to multiply them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p10">14. Sold them - That is, delivered them up, as the seller
doth his commodities unto the buyer.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p11">15. Whithersoever they went - That is, Whatsoever
expedition or business they undertook; which is usually signified by
going out, and coming in.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p12">16. Raised up - By inward inspiration and excitation of
their hearts, and by outward designation testified by some extra-
ordinary action. Judges - Supreme magistrates, whose office it was,
under God, and by his particular direction, to govern the commonwealth
of Israel by God's laws, and to protect and save them from their
enemies, to preserve and purge religion, and to maintain the liberties
of the people against all oppressors.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p13">17. Their Judges - Who admonished them of their sin and
folly, and of the danger and misery which would certainly befall
them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p14">18. It repented the Lord - That is, the Lord changed his
course and dealings with them, as penitent men use to do; removed his
judgments, and returned to them in mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p15">19. Returned - To their former, and usual course. Their
fathers - In Egypt, or in the wilderness. Their own doings - That is,
from their evil practices, which he calls their own, because they were
agreeable to their own natures, which in all mankind are deeply and
universally corrupted, and because they were familiar and customary to
them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iii.ii-p16">22. May prove - That I may try and see whether Israel
will be true and faithful to me, or whether they will suffer themselves
to be corrupted by the counsels and examples of their bad
neighbours.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="55.29%" prev="ii.viii.iii.ii" next="ii.viii.iv.i" id="ii.viii.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges III" id="ii.viii.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="55.29%" prev="ii.viii.iv" next="ii.viii.iv.ii" id="ii.viii.iv.i">

<p id="ii.viii.iv.i-p1">A general account of Israel's enemies, ver. 1-7. A
particular account of Othniel, ver. 8-11, Of Ehud, ver. 12-30. and of
Shamgar, ver. 31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="55.29%" prev="ii.viii.iv.i" next="ii.viii.v" id="ii.viii.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p1">1. Had not known - That is, such as had no experience of
those wars, nor of God's extraordinary power and providence manifested
in them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p2">2. Teach them war - That by the neighbourhood of such
warlike enemies, they might be purged from sloth and security, and
obliged them to innure themselves to martial exercises, and to stand
continually upon their guard, and consequently to keep close to that God
whose assistance they had so great and constant need of.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p3">3. Five lords - Whereof three had been in some sort
subdued, chap. i, 18. but afterwards recovered their strength.
Canaanites - Properly so called, who were very numerous, and dispersed
through several parts of the land, whence they gave denomination to all
the rest of the people. Zidonions - The people living near Zidon, and
subject to its jurisdiction. Baal-hermon - Which was the eastern part
about Lebanon.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p4">4. To know - That is, that they and others might know by
experience.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p5">6. Served their gods - Were drawn to idolatry by the
persuasions and examples of their yoke-fellows.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p6">7. And the groves - That is, in the groves, in which the
Heathens usually worshipped their Baalim or idols.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p7">8. Served - That is, were made subject to him.
Mesopotamia was that part of Syria which lay between the two great
rivers, Tigris and Euphrates. This lay at such a distance, that one
would not have thought Israel's trouble should have come from such a far
country: which shews so much the more of the hand of God in it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p8">9. Cried - That is, prayed fervently for deliverance.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p9">10. Came upon him - With extraordinary influence,
endowing him with singular wisdom and courage, and stirring him up to
this great undertaking. Judged Israel - That is, pleaded and avenged the
cause of Israel against their oppressors.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p10">11. Forty years - It rested about forty years, or the
greatest part of forty years: it being most frequent in scripture to use
numbers in such a latitude. Nor is it unusual either in scripture, or in
other authors, for things to be denominated from the greater part;
especially, when they enjoyed some degrees of rest and peace even in
their times of slavery.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p11">12. Strengthened Eglon - By giving him courage, and
power, and success against them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p12">13. City of Palm-trees - That is, Jericho. Not the city
which was demolished, but the territory belonging to it. Here he fixed
his camp, for the fertility of that soil, and because of its nearness to
the passage over Jordan, which was most commodious both for the
conjunction of his own forces which lay on both sides of Jordan; to
prevent the conjunction of the Israelites in Canaan with their brethren
beyond Jordan; and to secure his retreat into his own country.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p13">14. Eighteen years - The former servitude lasted but
eight years; this eighteen: for if smaller troubles do not the work, God
will send greater.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p14">15. A Benjamite - This tribe was next to Eglon, and
doubtless most afflicted by him; and hence God raiseth a deliverer. Left
handed - Which is here noted, as a considerable circumstance in the
following story.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p15">16. A cubit length - Long enough for his design, and not
too long for concealment. His right thigh - Which was most convenient
both for the use of his left hand, and for avoiding suspicion.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p16">17. The present - Which was to be paid to him as a part
of his tribute.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p17">18. Sent the people - He accompanied them part of the
way, and then dismissed them, and returned to Eglon alone, that so he
might have more easy access to him.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p18">19. Turned again - As if he had forgot some important
business. Keep silence - 'Till my servants be gone: whom he would not
have acquainted with a business which he supposed to be of great
importance.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p19">20. A summer parlor - Into which he used to retire from
company: which is mentioned as the reason why his servants waited so
long ere they went in to him, ver. 25. A message - To be delivered not
in words, but by actions. He designedly uses the name Elohim, which was
common to the true God, and false ones; and not Jehovah, which was
peculiar to the true God; because Ehud not knowing whether the message
came; not from his own false God, he would more certainly rise, and
thereby give Ehud more advantage for his blow; whereas he would possibly
shew his contempt of the God of Israel by sitting still to hear his
message. He arose - In token of reverence to God.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p20">23. Went forth - With a composed countenance and gait,
being well assured, that God, who by his extraordinary call had put him
upon that enterprise, would by his special providence carry him through
it. Upon him - Upon or after himself. Locked them - Either pulling it
close after him, as we do when doors have spring locks; or taking the
key with him.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p21">24. Covereth his feet - This phrase is used only here,
and <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxiv. 3" id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p21.1" parsed="|1Sam|24|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.24.3">1 Sam. xxiv, 3</scripRef>. A late judicious interpreter expounds it, of composing
himself to take a little sleep, as was very usual to do in the day- time
in those hot countries. And when they did so in cool places, such as
this summer parlor unquestionably was, they used to cover their feet.
And this may seem to be the more probable, both because the summer
parlor was proper for this use, and because this was a more likely
reason of their long waiting at his door, lest they should disturb his
repose. And this sense best agrees with Saul's case in the cave, when
being asleep, David could more securely cut off the lap of his
garment.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p22">25. Ashamed - Or, confounded, not knowing what to say or
think; lest they should either disturb him, or be guilty of neglect
towards him. A key - Another key, it being usual in princes courts to
have divers keys for the same door.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p23">27. The children of Israel - Whom doubtless he had
prepared by his emissaries gathered together in considerable
numbers.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p24">28. Fords of Jordan - Where they passed over Jordan, that
neither the Moabites that were got into Canaan, might escape, nor any
more Moabites come over Jordan to their succor.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p25">30. Fourscore years - Chiefly that part of it which lay
east of Jordan: for the other side of the country, which lay southwest,
was even then infested by the Philistines.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.iv.ii-p26">31. An ox goad - As Samson did a thousand with the
jaw-bone of an ass; both being miraculous actions, and not at all
incredible to him that believes a God, who could easily give strength to
effect this. It is probable Shamgar was following the plough, when the
Philistines made an inroad into the country. And having neither sword
nor spear, when God put it into his heart to oppose them, he took the
instrument that was next at hand. It is no matter how weak the weapon
is, if God direct and strengthen the arm.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="55.40%" prev="ii.viii.iv.ii" next="ii.viii.v.i" id="ii.viii.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges IV" id="ii.viii.v-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="55.40%" prev="ii.viii.v" next="ii.viii.v.ii" id="ii.viii.v.i">

<p id="ii.viii.v.i-p1">Israel revolting from God is oppressed by Jabin, ver.
1-3. Deborah concerts their deliverance with Barak, ver. 4-9. Barak
takes the field and conquers, ver. 10-16. Sisera flies and is killed,
ver. 17-21. Barak sees him, and Israel is delivered, ver. 22-24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="55.41%" prev="ii.viii.v.i" next="ii.viii.vi" id="ii.viii.v.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p1">2. Of Canaan - That is, of the land where most of the
Canaanites, strictly so called, now dwelt, which seems to be in the
northern part of Canaan. This seems to be of the posterity of that
Jabin, whom Joshua slew, <scripRef passage="Josh. xi. 11" id="ii.viii.v.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Josh|11|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.11.11">Josh. xi, 11</scripRef>, who watched all opportunities to recover his ancient
possessions, and to revenge his own and his father's quarrel. In Hazor -
In the territory or the kingdom of Hazor, which might now be restored to
its former largeness and power. Of the Gentiles - So called, because it
was much frequented and inhabited by the Gentiles; either by the
Canaanites, who being beaten out of their former possessions, seated
themselves in those northern parts; or by other nations coming there for
traffick, whence Galilee, where this was, is called Galilee of the
Gentiles.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p2">3. Mightily oppressed - More than former tyrants; from
his malice and hatred against the Israelites; and from God's just
judgment, the growing punishment being suitable to their aggravated
wickedness.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p3">4. A prophetess - As there were men-prophets, so there
were also women-prophetesses, as Miriam, <scripRef passage="Exod. xv. 20" id="ii.viii.v.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Exod|15|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.15.20">Exod. xv, 20</scripRef>. Huldah, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xxii. 14" id="ii.viii.v.ii-p3.2" parsed="|2Kgs|22|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.22.14">2 Kings xxii, 14</scripRef>, and divers others; but the word prophets or prophetesses is
ambiguous, sometimes being used of persons extraordinarily inspired by
God, and endowed with the power of working miracles, and foretelling
things to come; and sometimes of persons endowed with special gifts or
graces, for the better understanding and discoursing about the word and
mind of God. Of this sort were the sons of the prophets, or such as were
bred in the schools of the prophets. who are often called prophets, as <scripRef passage="1 Sam. x. 5, 10" id="ii.viii.v.ii-p3.3" parsed="|1Sam|10|5|0|0;|1Sam|10|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.10.5 Bible:1Sam.10.10">1 Sam. x, 5, 10</scripRef>. And because we read nothing of Deborah's miraculous
actions, perhaps she was only a woman of eminent holiness, and knowledge
of the holy scriptures, by which she was singularly qualified for
judging the people according to the laws of God. Judged Israel - That
is, determined causes and controversies arising among the Israelites, as
is implied, ver. 5. And this Jabin might suffer to be done, especially
by a woman. Yet the frequent discharge of this part of the judge's
office, whereby she gained great power and authority with the people,
did notably (though not observed by the tyrant) prepare the way for her
sliding into the other part of her office, which was to defend and
rescue the people from their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p4">5. And she dwelt - Or, she sat: she had her judgment-seat
in the open air, under the shadow of that tree; which was an emblem of
the justice she administered there: thriving and growing against
opposition, as the palm-tree does under pressures. Came to her - To have
their suits and causes determined by her sentence.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p5">6. Called Barak - By virtue of that power which God had
given her, and the people owned in her. Kedesh Naphtali - So called, to
distinguish it from other places of that name, one in Judah, and another
in Issachar. Hath not the Lord, &amp;c. - That is, assuredly God hath
commanded thee; this is not the fancy of a weak woman, which
peradventure thou mayst despise; but the command of the great God by my
mouth. Mount Tabor - A place most fit for his purpose, as being in the
borders of divers tribes, and having a large plain at the top of it,
where he might conveniently marshal and discipline his army. Naphtali
and Zebulun - These she names because they were nearest and best known
to Barak, and therefore soonest brought together, because they were
nearest to the enemy, and therefore might speedily be assembled, whilst
the other tribes, being at a distance, had better opportunity of
gathering forces for their succor; and because these had most smarted
under this oppressor, who was in the heart of their country; but these
are not named exclusively, as appears by the concurrence of some other
tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p6">7. Draw to Thee - By my secret and powerful providence,
ordering and over-ruling his inclinations that way. In fixing the very
place, she gave him a sign, which might confirm his faith, when he came
to engage.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p7">8. I will not go - His offer to go with her, shews the
truth of his faith, for which he is praised, <scripRef passage="Hebrew xi. 32" id="ii.viii.v.ii-p7.1">Hebrew xi, 32</scripRef>, but his refusal to go without her, shews the weakness of
his faith, that he could not trust God's bare word, as he ought to have
done, without the pledge of the presence of his prophetess.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p8">10. Ten thousand at his feet - That is, who followed him;
possibly he intimates that they were all foot-men; and so this is
emphatically added, to signify by what contemptible means God overthrew
Sisera's great host.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p9">11. Heber - The husband of Jael. Of Hobab - Called also
Jethro. The Kenites - From the rest of his brethren, who lived in the
wilderness of Judah. His tent - That is, his dwelling, which probably
was in tents, as shepherds used.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p10">12. They - That is, this people dwelling there, or his
spies.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p11">14. Up - Hebrew. arise, delay not. If we have ground to
believe, that God goes before us, we may well go on with courage and
cheerfulness. Gone before thee - Namely, as general of thine army, to
fight for thee. Went down - He doth not make use of the advantage which
he had of the hill, where he might have been out of the reach of his
iron chariots, but boldly marcheth down into the valley, to give Sisera
the opportunity of using all his horses and chariots, that so the
victory might he more glorious.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p12">15. Discomfited - With great terror and noise, as the
word signifies, probably with thunder and lightning, and hail-stones,
poured upon them from heaven, as is implied, chap. v, 20. Edge of the
sword - That is, by the sword of Barak and his army, whose ministry God
used; but so, that they had little else to do, but to kill those whom
God by more powerful arms had put to flight. On his feet - That he might
flee away more secretly in the quality of a common soldier, whereas his
chariot would have exposed him to more observation.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p13">16. Left - In the field; for there were some who fled
away, as Sisera did.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p14">17. The tent of Jael - For women had their tents apart
from their husbands. And here he thought to lurk more securely than in
her husband's tent. Peace - Not a covenant of friendship, which they
were forbidden to make with that cursed people, but only a cessation of
hostilities, which he afforded them because they were peaceable people,
abhorring war, and wholly minding pasturage, and were not Israelites,
with whom his principal quarrel was; and especially by God's over-ruling
disposal of his heart to favour them who were careful to keep themselves
uncorrupted with Israel's sins, and therefore preserved from their
plagues.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p15">18. Fear not - This was a promise of security, and
therefore she cannot be excused from dissimulation and treachery.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p16">19. A bottle of milk - As a signification of greater
respect. Covered him - Upon pretense of hiding him.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.v.ii-p17">21. A nail of the tent - Wherewith they used to fasten
the tent, which consequently was long and sharp. This might seem a very
bold attempt, but it must be considered, that she was encouraged to it,
by observing that the heavens and all the elements conspired against
him, as one devoted to destruction. In the following son, Deborah doth
not commend Jael's words, ver. 18. Turn in my Lord, fear not; but only
her action: touching which, this one consideration may abundantly
suffice to stop the mouths of objectors. It cannot be denied, that every
discourse which is recorded in scripture, is not divinely inspired,
because some of them were uttered by the devil, and others by holy men,
but mistaken. This being so, the worst that any can infer from this
place is, that this song, tho' indited by a good woman, was not divinely
inspired, but only composed by a person transported with joy for the
deliverance of God's people, but subject to mistake; who therefore, out
of zeal to commend the instrument of so great a deliverance, might
overlook the indirectness of the means, and commend that which should
have been disliked, And if they farther object, that it was composed by
a prophetess, and therefore must be divinely inspired; it may be
replied, that every expression of a true prophet was not divinely
inspired; as is evident from Samuel's mistake concerning Eliab, whom he
thought to be the Lord's anointed, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xvi. 6" id="ii.viii.v.ii-p17.1" parsed="|1Sam|16|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.16.6">1 Sam. xvi, 6</scripRef>. This is said upon supposition that Jael acted deceitfully
in this affair; but if we suppose, which is much more likely, that Jael
fully intended to afford Sisera the shelter and protection which he
sought of her, but was afterwards by the immediate direction of heaven
ordered to kill him, the whole difficulty vanishes, and the character
both of Jael and of Deborah remains unimpeached.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="55.56%" prev="ii.viii.v.ii" next="ii.viii.vi.i" id="ii.viii.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges V" id="ii.viii.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="55.56%" prev="ii.viii.vi" next="ii.viii.vi.ii" id="ii.viii.vi.i">

<p id="ii.viii.vi.i-p1">Deborah's song begins with praise, ver. 1-3. Compares
God's present appearance for them with his appearance on Mount Sinai,
ver. 4-5. Describes the condition they were in before, ver. 6-8. Calls
all the delivered to join in praise, ver. 9-13. Commends those tribes
that were forward in the war, and censures those that declined the
service, ver. 14-19. Takes notice how God fought for them, and how Jael
slew Sisera, ver. 20-30. Concludes with prayer, ver.. 31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="55.57%" prev="ii.viii.vi.i" next="ii.viii.vii" id="ii.viii.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p1">1. Deborah - The composer of this song.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p2">2. The Lord-Give him the praise who hath done the work.
The people - Chiefly Zebulun and Naphtali. Offered themselves - When
neither Deborah nor Barak had any power to compel them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p3">3. The princes - You especially that live near, and have
evil designs against Israel, know this for your caution, and terror too,
if you presume to molest them. God of Israel - Who, as you see by this
plain instance, is both able and resolved to defend them from all their
enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p4">4. Edom - Seir and Edom are the same place; and these two
expressions note the same thing, even God's marching in the head of his
people, from Seir or Edom, towards the land of Canaan: while the
Israelites were encompassing mount Seir, there were none of the
following effects; but when once they had done that, and got Edom on
their backs, then they marched directly forward towards the land of
Canaan. The prophetess being to praise God for the present mercies,
takes her rise higher, and begins her song with the commemoration of the
ancient deliverances afforded by God to his people, the rather because
of the great resemblance this had with them, in the miraculous manner of
them. The earth trembled - God prepared the way for his people, and
struck a dread into their enemies, by earth-quakes as well as by other
terrible signs. Dropped water - That is, thou didst send storms and
tempests, thunder and lightning, and other tokens of thy displeasure
upon thine enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p5">5. Melted - Or, flowed, with floods of water powered out
of the clouds upon them, and from them flowing down in a mighty stream
upon the lower grounds, and carrying down part of the mountains with it.
Sinai - She slides into the mention of a more ancient appearance of God
for his people in Sinai; it being usual in scripture repetitions of
former actions, to put divers together in a narrow compass. The sense
is, No wonder that the mountains of the Amorites and Canaanites melted
and trembled, when thou didst lead thy people toward them; for even
Sinai itself could not bear thy presence, but melted in like manner
before thee.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p6">6. Jael - Jael, though an illustrious woman, effected
nothing for the deliverance of God's people, 'till God raised me up.
By-ways - Because of the Philistines and Canaanites, who, besides the
public burdens which they laid upon them, waited for all opportunities
to do them mischief secretly; their soldiers watching for travelers in
common roads, as is usual with such in times of war; and, because of the
robbers even of their own people, who having cast off the fear of God,
and there being no king in Israel to punish them, broke forth into acts
of injustice and violence, even against their own brethren.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p7">7. Ceased - The people forsook all their unfortified
towns, not being able to protect them from military insolence. A mother
- That is, to be to them as a mother, to instruct, and rule, and protect
them, which duties a mother owes to her children.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p8">8. Chose - They did not only submit to idolatry when they
were forced to it by tyrants, but they freely chose it. New gods - New
to them, and unknown to their fathers, and new in comparison of the true
and everlasting God of Israel, being but of yesterday. The gates - That
is, in their walled cities, which have gates and bars; gates are often
put for cities; then their strong holds fell into the hands of their
enemies. Was there a shield - There was not, the meaning is not, that
all the Israelites had no arms, but, either they had but few arms among
them, being many thousands of them disarmed by the Canaanites and
Philistines, or that they generally neglected the use of arms, as being
without all hope of recovering their liberty.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p9">9. My heart is toward - I honour and love those, who
being the chief of the people in wealth and dignity, did not withdraw
themselves from the work, as such usually do; but exposed themselves to
the same hazards, and joined with their brethren in this noble but
dangerous attempt. The Lord - Who inclined their hearts to this
undertaking, and gave them success in it. As she gives instruments their
due, so she is careful the sovereign cause lose not his glory.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p10">10. Speak - Celebrate the praise of our mighty God. That
ride on white asses - That is, magistrates and nobles, who used to do
so, chap. x, 4; xii, 14. That walk - That is, you that can safely travel
in those high ways, which before you durst neither ride nor walk in: so
great and mean persons are jointly excited to praise God.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p11">11. From the noise - From the triumphant noise and shout
of archers, rejoicing when they meet with their prey. Of drawing water -
At those pits or springs of water, which were precious in those hot
countries, to which the people's necessities forced them to resort, and
nigh unto which the archers usually lurked, that they may shoot at them,
and kill and spoil them. There - When they come to those places with
freedom and safety, which before they could not, they shall with
thankfulness rehearse this righteous and gracious work of God, in
rescuing his people. Of the villages - Whom she mentions, because as
their danger was greater, ver. 7, so was their deliverance. Gates - Of
their cities, which were the chief places to which both city and country
resorted for public business and matters of justice, from which they
they had been debarred by their oppressors; but now they had free access
and passage, either in or out of the gates, as their occasions required;
and they who had been driven from their cities, now returned to them in
peace and triumph; so the citizens deliverance is celebrated here, as
the country-mens is in the foregoing words.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p12">12. Awake - Stir up thyself and all that is within thee,
to admire and praise the Lord. This work needs and well deserves the
utmost liveliness and vigour of soul. Lead captivity captive - How could
this be done, when there was none of them left? chap. iv, 16.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p13">1. None were left to make head against
them.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p14">2. None is often put for few, and those few
might be taken after the battle, and carried captive, and led in
triumph.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p15">13. He made him, &amp;c. - Thus God did not only preserve
the poor and despised remnant of his people, from the fury of the
oppressor, and from the destruction which Sisera designed, but also gave
them the victory, and thereby the dominion over the nobles of Canaan,
who were combined against them. Me - Tho' but a weak woman.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p16">14. Ephraim - Now she relates the carriage of the several
tribes in the expedition; and she begins with Ephraim. A root - Of the
Ephraimites. By root she seems to mean a branch, as that word is
sometimes used. By which also she may note the fewness of those that
came out of Ephraim, yielding but one branch or an handful of men to
this service. Amalek - The constant enemy of the Israelites, who were
confederate with their last oppressors the Moabites, chap. iii, 13, and
in all probability took their advantage now against the Israelites in
the southern or middle parts of Canaan, while their main force was drawn
northward against Jabin and Sisera. Against these therefore Ephraim sent
forth a party, and so did Benjamin. Benjamin - Benjamin followed
Ephraim's example. The people - Among the people of Benjamin, with whom
these few Ephraimites united themselves in this expedition. Machir -
That is, out of the tribe of Manasseh, which are elsewhere called by the
name of Machir, namely, out of the half tribe which was within Jordan;
for of the other she speaks, ver.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p17">17. Governors - Either civil governors, princes and great
persons, who were as ready to hazard themselves, as the meanest: or
military officers, valiant and expert commanders, such as some of
Machir's posterity are noted to have been. Writer - That is, even the
Scribes, who gave themselves to study and writing, whereby they were
exempted from military service, did voluntarily enter into this
service.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p18">15. With Deborah - Ready to assist her. Issachar -
Hebrew. and Issachar, that is, the tribe or people of Issachar,
following the counsel and example of their princes. Barak - That is,
they were as hearty and valiant as Barak their general; and as he
marched on foot against their enemies horses and chariots, and that into
the valley, where the main use of horses and chariots lies; so did they
with no less courage and resolution. Divisions - Or, separations, not so
much one from another, (for they seem to be all so well agreed in
abiding at home with their sheep) as all from their brethren, from whom
they were divided no less in their designs and affections, than in their
situation by the river Jordan: and they would not join their interests
and forces with them in this common cause. Great thoughts - Or, great
searchings, great and sad thoughts, and debates, and perplexities of
mind among the Israelites, to see themselves deserted by so great and
potent a tribe as Reuben was.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p19">16. Why abodest - Why wast thou so unworthy and cowardly,
that thou wouldest not engage thyself in so just, so necessary, and so
noble a cause, but didst prefer the care of this sheep, and thy own ease
and safety, before this generous undertaking? Reuben thought neutrality
their wisest course; being very rich in cattle, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxii. 1" id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Num|32|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.32.1">Num. xxxii, 1</scripRef>. They were loath to run the hazard of so great a loss, by
taking up arms against so potent an enemy as Jabin: and the bleatings of
their sheep were so loud in their ears, that they could not hear the
call of Deborah and Barak.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p20">17. Gilead - Sometimes taken strictly for that part of
the land beyond Jordan which fell to the half-tribe of Manasseh, and
sometimes both for that part of Manasseh's, and for Gad's portion, as <scripRef passage="Josh. xiii. 24-25" id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p20.1" parsed="|Josh|13|24|13|25" osisRef="Bible:Josh.13.24-Josh.13.25">Josh. xiii, 24-25</scripRef>, 29-31, and so it seems to be understood here; and the land
Gilead is here put for the people or inhabitants of it, Gad and
Manasseh. Beyond Jordan - In their own portions, and did not come over
Jordan to the help of the Lord, and of his people, as they ought to have
done. In ships - Daniel, whose coast was near the sea, was wholly intent
upon his merchandise, and therefore could not join in this land
expedition. Sea-shore - Where their lot lay. His breaches - Either in
the creeks of the sea, or, in their broken and craggy rocks and
caves.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p21">18. Jeoparded - Hebrew. despised, comparatively; they
chose rather to venture upon a generous and honourable death, than to
enjoy a shameful and servile life. High-places - That is, upon that
large and eminent plain in the top of mount Tabor, where they put
themselves in battle array, and expected the enemy; though when they saw
they did not come up to them, they marched down to meet them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p22">19. The kings - There were divers petty kings in those
parts who were subject to Jabin. Megiddo - Taanah and Megiddo were two
eminent cities, not far from mount Tabor, nor from the river Kishon. No
gain - They fought without pay, whether from mere hatred of the
Israelites, and a desire to be revenged upon them: or from a full hope
and confidence of paying themselves abundantly out of Israel's
spoils.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p23">20. From heaven - Or, they from heaven, or the heavenly
host fought, by thunder, and lightning, and hail-stones, possibly
mingled with fire. The stars - Raising these storms by their influences,
which they do naturally. Courses - Or, from their paths, or stations. As
soldiers fight in their ranks and places assigned them, so did
these.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p24">21. River of Kishon - Which, though not great in itself,
was now much swelled by the foregoing storm and rain, and therefore
drowned those who being pursued by the hand of God, and by the
Israelites, were forced into it, and thought to pass over it, as they
did before. Ancient river - So called, either, first, in opposition to
those rivers which are of a later date, being made by the hand and art
of man. Or, secondly, because it was a river anciently famous for
remarkable exploits, for which it was celebrated by the ancient poets or
writers, though not here mentioned. Trodden down - Thou, O Deborah,
though but a weak woman, hast by God's assistance subdued a potent
enemy. Such abrupt speeches are frequent in poetical scriptures.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p25">22. Horses hoofs - Their horses, in which they put most
confidence, had their hoofs, which are their support and strength,
broken, either by dreadful hail-stones, or rather, by their swift and
violent running over the stony grounds, when they fled with all possible
speed from God and from Israel. Pransings - Or because of their fierce
or swift courses. Mighty ones - Of their strong and valiant riders, who
forced their horses to run away as fast as they could.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p26">23. Meroz - A place then, no doubt, eminent and
considerable, tho' now there be no remembrance of it left, which
possibly might be the effect of this bitter curse; as God curseth Amalek
in this manner, that he would utterly blot out their remembrance. And
this place above all others may be thus severely cursed; because it was
near the place of the fight, and therefore had the greatest opportunity
and obligation to assist their brethren. The angel, &amp;c. - She
signifies, that this curse proceeded not from her ill-will towards that
place, but from divine inspiration; and that if all the rest of the song
should be taken but for the breathings of a pious soul, but liable to
mistake, yet this branch of it was immediately directed to her by the
Lord, the angel of the covenant. Of the Lord - Of the Lord's people: for
God takes what is done for, or against his people, as if it was done to
himself. The cause between God and the mighty, the principalities and
powers of the kingdom of darkness, will not admit of a neutrality.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p27">24. Blessed - Celebrated, and endowed with all sorts of
blessings more than they. In the tent - In her tent or habitation, in
her house and family, and all her affairs: for she and hers dwelt in
tents. The tent is here mentioned as an allusion to the place where the
fact was done.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p28">25. Butter - Or, cream, that is, the choicest of her
milk: so the same thing is repeated in different words. Lordly dish -
Which you are not to understand of such a costly dish as the luxury of
after ages brought in, which is not agreeable to the simplicity either
of this family, or of those ancient times; but of a comely and
convenient dish, the best which she had, and such as the better sort of
persons then used. Probably Jael at that time intended him no other than
kindness, 'till God by an immediate impulse on her mind, directed her to
do otherwise.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p29">28. Looked out - Expecting to see him returning: for she
concluded, that he went forth not so much to fight, as to take the
spoil.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p30">30. Have they not, &amp;e. - That is, it is certain they
have got the prey, only they tarry to distribute it, according to every
man's quality and merit.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vi.ii-p31">31. So let - That is, so suddenly, so surely, so
effectual and irrecoverably. Deborah was a prophetess and this prayer
was a prediction, that in due time all God's enemies shall perish. In
his might - When he first riseth, and so goeth on in his course, which
he doth with great might, even as a strong man that runneth a race, and
so as no creature can stop, or hinder him; even so irresistible let thy
people be. Such shall be the honour and such the joy of all that love
God in sincerity, and they shall shine forever as the sun in the
kingdom of their father.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="55.84%" prev="ii.viii.vi.ii" next="ii.viii.vii.i" id="ii.viii.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges VI" id="ii.viii.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="55.84%" prev="ii.viii.vii" next="ii.viii.vii.ii" id="ii.viii.vii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.vii.i-p1">The calamities of Israel by the Midianites, ver. 1-6. The
message God sent them by a prophet, ver. 7-10. God's commission to
Gideon, confirmed by a sign, ver. 11-24. He breaks down the altar of
Baal, ver. 25-32. The preparation for war, and encouragement by another
sign, ver. 33-40.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="55.84%" prev="ii.viii.vii.i" next="ii.viii.viii" id="ii.viii.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p1">1. Of Midian - For although the generality of the
Midianites had been cut off by Moses about two hundred years ago, yet
many of them doubtless fled into the neighbouring countries, whence
afterwards they returned into their own land, and in that time might
easily grow to be a very great number; especially, when God furthered
their increase, that they might be a scourge for Israel when they
transgressed. Let all that sin, expect to suffer: let all that turn to
folly, expect to return to misery.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p2">3. Children of the east - That is, the Arabians, who are
commonly called the children of the east. Not all the Arabians; but the
eastern part of them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p3">4. Unto Gaza - That is, from the east, on which side they
entered, to the well, where Gaza was, near the sea: so they destroyed
the whole land.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p4">5. Without number - That is, so many that it was not easy
to number them. And not in a regular army to engage, but in a confused
swarm, to plunder the country. Yet Israel, being forsaken of God, had
not spirit to make head against them; God fighting against them with
those very terrors, with which otherwise he would have fought for
them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p5">8. A prophet - We have reason to hope, God is designing
mercy for us, if we find he is by his grace preparing us for it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p6">10. Not obeyed my voice - He intends to bring them to
repentance. And our repentance is then genuine, when he sinfulness of
sin, as disobedience to God, is that in it which we chiefly lament.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p7">11. In Ophrah - In Manasseh: there was another Ophrah in
Benjamin, <scripRef passage="Josh. xviii. 23" id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Josh|18|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.18.23">Josh. xviii, 23</scripRef>. The Abi-ezrite - Of the posterity of Abiezer. Threshed -
Not with oxen, as the manner was, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 4" id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Deut|25|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.4">Deut. xxv, 4</scripRef>, but with a staff to prevent discovery. Wine-press - In the
place where the wine-press stood, not in the common floor.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p8">12. Is with thee - That is, will assist thee against
thine enemies. Man of valour - To whom I have given strength and courage
for this end.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p9">13. With us - The angel had said, Peace be with Thee: but
he expostulates for All: herding himself with all Israel, and admitting
no comfort, but what they might be sharers in.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p10">14. Looked - With a settled and pleasant countenance, as
a testimony of his favour, and readiness to help him. Go - Or, go now,
in thy might: in the strength which thou hast already received, and dost
now farther receive from me. Have not I sent thee - I do hereby give
thee command and commission for this work. God's fitting men for his
work, is a sure evidence of his calling them to it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p11">15. My family - Hebrew. my thousand: for the tribes were
distributed into several thousands, whereof each thousand had his
peculiar governor. Is poor - That is, weak and contemptible. The least -
Either for age, or fitness for so great a work.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p12">16. As one man - As easily, as if they were all but one
man.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p13">17. That thou - That it is thou, an angel or messenger
sent from God, that appears to me, and discourseth with me. Or, a sign
of that which thou talkest with me; that is, that thou wilt by me smite
the Midianites.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p14">18. My present - A repast for the angel, whom he thought
to be a man. Set it - That thou mayest eat and refresh thyself.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p15">19. An ephah - The choicest part of a whole ephah; as
also he brought to him the best part of a kid dressed; for a whole
ephah, and a whole kid had been superfluous, and improper to provide for
one man.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p16">21. Consumed the flesh - By which, he shewed himself to
be no man that needed such provisions, but the Son of God; and by this
instance of his omnipotency, gave him assurance, that he both could, and
would consume the Midianites.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p17">22. Alas - I am an undone man: I must die, and that
speedily; for that he feared, ver. 23, according to the common opinion
in that case.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p18">23. Said unto him - Perhaps by an audible voice. Peace be
to thee - Thou shalt receive no hurt by this vision; but only peace,
that is, all the blessings needful for thy own happiness, and for the
present work.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p19">24. There - On the top of the rock, as is evident from
ver. 26, where that which is here expressed only in general, is more
particularly described. Jehovah-shalom - That is, the Lord's peace; the
sign or witness of God's speaking peace to me, and to his people: or the
place where he spake peace to me, when I expected nothing but
destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p20">25. The second bullock - He was to offer one for himself,
the other for the sins of the people, whom he was to deliver. 'Till sin
be pardoned thro' the great sacrifice, no good is to be expected. Thy
father hath - Which thy father built in his own ground, tho' for the
common use of the city. The grove - Planted by the altar for idolatrous
uses, as the manner of idolaters was. This action might seem injurious
to his father's authority; but God's command was a sufficient warrant,
and Gideon was now called to be the supreme magistrate, whereby he was
made his father's superior, and was authorized to root out all idolatry,
and the instruments thereof.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p21">26. Of this rock - Hebrew. of this strong hold: for in
that calamitous time the Israelites retreated to such rocks, and hid and
fortified themselves in them. Ordered place - That is, in a plain and
smooth part of the rock, where an altar may be conveniently built. And
offer - Gideon was no priest, nor was this the appointed place of
sacrifice; but God can dispense with his own institutions, though we may
not; and his call gave Gideon sufficient authority.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p22">27. Ten men - Whom doubtless he had acquainted with his
design, and the assurance of success in it, whereby they were easily
induced to assist him. He feared - Not so much, lest he should suffer
for it, as lest he should be prevented from doing it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p23">28. Was offered - Not upon Baal's altar, for which it was
designed; but upon an altar erected in contempt of Baal.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p24">30. They said - Probably some of the persons employed in
it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p25">31. Will ye plead - Why are you so zealous in pleading
for that Baal, for the worship whereof you suffer such grievous
calamities at this day? It is plain, that Joash had been a worshipper of
Baal: but probably he was now convinced by Gideon. He that will plead -
He that shall farther plead for such a God as this, deserves to die for
his folly and impiety. It is not probable, that this was all which he
said for his son: but it is usual in scripture to give only short hints
of things which were more largely discoursed. While it is morning - That
is, instantly, without delay. Let him plead - As the God of Israel hath
often done when any indignity or injury hath been done him. But Baal
hath now shewed, that he is neither able to help you, nor himself; and
therefore is not worthy to be served any longer. This resolute answer
was necessary to stop the torrent of the peoples fury; and it was drawn
from him, by the sense of his son's extreme danger; and by the
confidence he had, that God would plead his son's cause, and use him for
the rescue of his people.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p26">32. He called - Joash called Gideon so, chap. viii, 29,
in remembrance of this noble exploit, and to put a brand upon Baal.
Jerub-baal - That is, Let Baal plead. It is a probable conjecture, that
that Jerombalus, whom Sanchoniathon, (one of the most ancient of all the
Heathen writers) speaks of as a priest of Jao, (a corruption of Jehovah)
and to whom he was indebted for a great deal of knowledge, was this
Jerub-baal.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p27">33. Of Jezreel - Not Jezreel in Judah, but another in the
borders of Manasseh and Issachar, which was not far distant from Ophrah,
where Gideon dwelt.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p28">34. The spirit came - Inspiring him with extraordinary
wisdom, and courage, and zeal to vindicate God's honour, and his
country's liberty. The Hebrew is, The Spirit of the Lord clothed Gideon;
clothed him as a robe, to put honour upon him; clothed him as a coat of
mail to put a defense upon him. Those are well clad that are thus
clothed. Abiezer - That is, the Abiezrites, his kindred, and their
servants, and others; who finding no harm coming to him for destroying
Baal, but rather a blessing from God, in giving him strength and courage
for so great an attempt, changed their minds, and followed him as the
person by whose hands God would deliver them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p29">35. All Manasseh - On Both sides of Jordan. Unto Asher,
&amp;c. - Because these tribes were nearest, and so could soonest join
with him; and were nearest the enemy also, ver. 33, and therefore were
most sensible of the calamity, and would in all reason be most forward
to rescue themselves from it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p30">36. Gideon said - In a way of humble supplication, for
the strengthening his own faith, and for the greater encouragement of
his soldiers in this great attempt.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p31">37. On all the earth - That is, upon all that spot of
ground which encompasses the fleece.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p32">39. On the ground - Which was more preternatural than the
former instance, because if there be any moisture, such bodies as
fleeces of wool are likely to drink it up.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.vii.ii-p33">40. And God did so - See how tender God is, even of the
weak; and how ready to condescend to their infirmities! These signs were
very expressive. They are going to engage the Midianites. Could God
distinguish between a small fleece of Israel, and the vast floor of
Midian? Yes, by this token it appears that he can. Is Gideon desirous,
that the dew of divine grace might descend on himself in particular? He
sees the fleece wet with dew, to assure him of it. Does he desire, that
God will be as the dew to all Israel? Behold all the ground is wet!</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="56.01%" prev="ii.viii.vii.ii" next="ii.viii.viii.i" id="ii.viii.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges VII" id="ii.viii.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="56.01%" prev="ii.viii.viii" next="ii.viii.viii.ii" id="ii.viii.viii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.viii.i-p1">God's direction to Gideon for modelling his army, ver.
1-8. The dream of the Midianite, ver. 9-15. His manner of attacking the
camp of Midian, ver. 16-20. Their total overthrow, ver. 21-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="56.01%" prev="ii.viii.viii.i" next="ii.viii.ix" id="ii.viii.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p1">2. Too many - For my purpose; which is, so to deliver
Israel, that it may appear to be my own act, that so I may have all the
glory, and they may be the more strongly obliged to serve me. This may
help us to understand those providences, which sometimes seem to weaken
the church of Christ. Its friends are too many, too mighty, too wise,
for God to work deliverance by. God is taking a course to lessen them,
that he may be exalted in his own strength.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p2">3. Mount Gilead - Not mount Gilead beyond Jordan; for
both the camps of the Israelites and the Midianites were on this side
Jordan: but another mount Gilead in the tribe of Manasseh. There
returned - These finding their whole army very small, in comparison of
their enemies, who were a hundred and thirty five thousand, chap. viii,
10, and they, no doubt well armed and disciplined, and encouraged by
long success; whereas the Israelites were dispirited with long
servitude, and many of them unarmed, lost the courage which they had at
first.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p3">4. The water - Either that which ran from the well of
Harod, mentioned ver. 1, or some other brook.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p4">6. That lapped - Taking up a little water in the palm of
their hands.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p5">7. His own place - That is, to his own home. By this
farther distinction it was proved, that none should be made use of,
but,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p6">1. Men that were hardy, that could endure
fatigue, without complaining of thirst or weariness:</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p7">2. Men that were hasty, that thought it
long, 'till they were engaged with the enemy, and so just wetted their
mouth and away, not staying for a full draught. Such as these God chuses
to employ, that are not only well affected, but zealously affected to
his work.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p8">8. Their trumpets - That is the trumpets belonging to the
whole army, which he retained for the use following.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p9">9. The same night - After he had dismissed all but the
three hundred. The Lord said - In a dream or vision of the night.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p10">11. Thine hand strengthened - Thou wilt be encourage to
proceed, notwithstanding the smallness of thy number.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p11">13. A cake - A weak and contemptible thing; and in itself
as unable to overthrow a tent, as to remove a mountain; but being thrown
by a divine hand, it bore down all before it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p12">14. His fellow answered, &amp;c. - As there are many
examples of significant dreams, given by God to Heathens, so some of
them had the gift of interpreting dreams; which they sometimes did by
divine direction as in this case.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p13">15. He worshipped-He praised God for this special
encouragement.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p14">16. Three companies - To make a shew of a vast army.
Within the pitchers - Partly to preserve the flame from the wind and
weather; and partly to conceal it, and surprise their enemy with sudden
flashes of light.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p15">17. Look on me - For though two hundred of his men were
placed on other sides of the camp; yet they were so disposed, that some
persons, set as watchmen, might see what was done, and give notice to
the rest to follow the example.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p16">18. Of Gideon - He mentions his own name, together with
God's, not out of arrogance, as if he would equal himself with God; but
from prudent policy, because his name was grown formidable to them, and
so was likely to further his design. See ver. 14.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p17">19. Middle watch - That is, of the second watch; for
though afterward the night was divided into four watches by the Romans, <scripRef passage="Matt. xiv. 25" id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Matt|14|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.14.25">Matt. xiv, 25</scripRef>, yet in more ancient times, and in the eastern parts, it was
divided into three: he chose the dark and dead of the night, to increase
their terror by the trumpets, whose sound would then be loudest, and the
lamps, whose light would then shine most brightly, to surprise them, and
conceal the smallness of their numbers.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p18">21. They stood - As if they had been torch-bearers to the
several companies.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p19">22. Against his fellow - They slew one another, because
they suspected treachery, and so fell upon those they first met with;
which they might more easily do, because they consisted of several
nations, because the darkness of the night made them unable to
distinguish friends from foes, because the suddenness of the thing
struck them with horror and amazement; and because God had infatuated
them, as he had done many others.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p20">24. The waters - That is, the passes over those waters to
which they are like to come. Jordan - The fords of Jordan, which they
must pass over into their own country.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.viii.ii-p21">25. The other side of Jordan - For Gideon in the pursuit
had passed over Jordan. Oreb and Zeeb had probably taken shelter, the
one in a rock, the other by a wine-press. But the places of their
shelter were made the places of their slaughter, and the memory of it
preserved in the names of the places.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="56.09%" prev="ii.viii.viii.ii" next="ii.viii.ix.i" id="ii.viii.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges VIII" id="ii.viii.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="56.09%" prev="ii.viii.ix" next="ii.viii.ix.ii" id="ii.viii.ix.i">

<p id="ii.viii.ix.i-p1">Gideon pacifies the Ephraimites, ver. 1-3. Pursues the
Midianites, ver. 4-12. Chastises the men of Succoth and Penuel, ver.
13-17. Slays the two kings of Midian, ver. 18-21. Declines the
government of Israel, ver. 22, 23. Makes an ephod, ver. 24-27. Keeps the
country quiet forty years, ver. 28. Dies, leaving a numerous family,
ver, 29-32. Israel quickly forget God and him, ver. 33-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="56.10%" prev="ii.viii.ix.i" next="ii.viii.x" id="ii.viii.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p1">1. Why haft thou, &amp;c. - Why hast thou neglected and
despised us, in not calling us in to thy help, as thou didst other
tribes? These were a proud people, puffed up with a conceit of their
number and strength, and the preference which Jacob gave them above
Manasseh, of which tribe Gideon was, who by this act had seemed to
advance his own tribe, and to depress theirs.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p2">2. What have I, &amp;c. - What I have done in cutting off
some of the common soldiers, is not to be compared with your destroying
their princes; I began the war, but you have finished. The gleaning -
What you have gleaned or done after me, Of Abiezer - That is, of the
Abiezrites, to whom he modestly communicates the honour of the victory,
and does not arrogate it to himself.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p3">3. Was abated - His soft and humble answer allayed their
rage.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p4">4. Passed over - Or, had passed over. 6. Are the hands,
&amp;c. - Art thou so foolish, to think with thy three hundred faint and
weary soldiers, to conquer and destroy an host of fifteen thousand Men?
Thus the bowels of their compassion were shut up against their brethren.
Were these Israelites! Surely they were worshippers of Baal, or in the
interest of Midian.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p5">8. Penuel - Another city beyond Jordan; both were in the
tribe of Gad.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p6">9. Your tower - Your confidence in which makes you thus
proud and presumptuous.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p7">10. That drew sword - That is, persons expert and
exercised in war, besides the retainers to them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p8">11. That dwelt in tents - That is, of the Arabians, so
fetching a compass, and falling upon them where they least expected it.
Was secure - Being now got safe over Jordan, and a great way from the
place of battle; and probably, supposing Gideon's men to be so tired
with their hard service, that they would have neither strength nor will
to pursue them so far.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p9">13. Before the sun was up - By which it might be
gathered, that he came upon them in the night, which was most convenient
for him who had so small a number with him; and most likely to terrify
them by the remembrance of the last Night's sad work.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p10">14. He described - He told him their names and
qualities.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p11">17. Slew the men of the city - Not all of them; probably
those only who had affronted him.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p12">18. What manner of men - For outward shape and quality.
At Tabor - Whither he understood they fled for shelter, upon the
approach of the Midianites; and where he learned that some were slain,
which he suspected might be them. Resembled - Not for their garb, or
outward splendour, but for the majesty of their looks: by which
commendation they thought to ingratiate themselves with their
conqueror.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p13">19. I would not slay - For being not Canaanites, he was
not obliged to kill them; but they having killed his brethren, and that
in cool blood, he was by law the avenger of their blood.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p14">20. Up, and slay - That he might animate him to the use
of arms for his God and country, and that he might have a share in the
honour of the victory.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p15">21. So is his strength - Thou excellest him, as in age
and stature, so in strength; and it is more honourable to die by the
hands of a valiant man.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p16">22. Rule - Not as a judge, for that he was already made
by God; but as a king. Thy son's son - Let the kingdom be hereditary to
thee, and to thy family. Thou hast delivered us - This miraculous and
glorious deliverance by thy hands deserves no less from us.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p17">23. I will not rule - As a king. The Lord shall rule - In
a special manner, as he hath hitherto done, by Judges, whom God
particularly appointed and directed, even by Urim and Thummim, and
assisted upon all occasions; whereas Kings had only a general dependance
upon God.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p18">24. Ishmaelites - A mixture of people all called by one
general name, Ishmaelites or Arabians, who used to wear ear-rings; but
the greatest, and the ruling part of them were Midianites.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p19">27. Thereof - Not of all of it; for then it would have
been too heavy for use; but of part of it, the rest being probably
employed about other things appertaining to it; which elsewhere are
comprehended under the name of the ephod, as chap. xvii, 5. Put it - Not
as a monument of the victory, for such monuments were neither proper nor
usual; but for religious use, for which alone the ephod was appointed.
The case seems to be this; Gideon having by God's command erected an
altar in his own city, Ophrah, ch. vi, 24, for an extraordinary time and
occasion, thought it might be continued for ordinary use; and therefore
as he intended to procure priests, so he designed to make priestly
garments, and especially an ephod, which was the chief and most costly;
which besides its use in sacred ministrations, was also the instrument
by which the mind of God was inquired and discovered, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxvi. 6, 9" id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p19.1" parsed="|1Sam|26|6|0|0;|1Sam|26|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.26.6 Bible:1Sam.26.9">1 Sam. xxvi, 6, 9</scripRef>, and it might seen necessary for the judge to have this at
hand, that he might consult with God upon all occasions. Went a whoring
- Committed idolatry with it; or went thither to inquire the will of
God; whereby they were drawn from the true ephod, instituted by God for
this end, which was to be worn by the high- priest only. A snare - An
occasion of sin and ruin to him and his, as the next chapter sheweth.
Though Gideon was a good man, and did this with an honest mind, and a
desire to set up religion in his own city and family; yet here seem to
be many sins in it;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p20">1. Superstition and will-worship,
worshipping God by a device of his own, which was expressly
forbidden.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p21">2. Presumption, in wearing or causing other
priests to wear this kind of ephod, which was peculiar to the
high-priest.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p22">3. Transgression of a plain command, of
worshipping God ordinarily but at one place, and one altar, <scripRef passage="Deut. xii. 5, 11, 14" id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p22.1" parsed="|Deut|12|5|0|0;|Deut|12|11|0|0;|Deut|12|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.12.5 Bible:Deut.12.11 Bible:Deut.12.14">Deut. xii, 5, 11, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p23">4. Making a division among the people.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p24">5. Laying a stumbling-block, or an occasion
of idolatry before that people, whom he knew to be too prone to it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p25">28. Lifted up their head - That is, recovered not their
former strength or courage, so as to conquer or oppress others. Forty
years - To the fortieth year, from the beginning of the Midianitish
oppression. The days, &amp;c. - As long as Gideon lived.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p26">29. His own house - Not in his father's house; as he did
before; nor yet in a court like a king, as the people desired; but in a
middle state, as a judge for the preservation and maintenance of their
religion and liberties.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p27">31. Shechem - She dwelt there, and he often came thither,
either to execute judgment, or upon other occasions. Abimelech - That
is, my father the king; so he called him, probably, to gratify his
concubine, who desired it either out of pride, or design.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p28">32. A good old age - His long life being crowned with the
continuance of honour, tranquility, and happiness.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.ix.ii-p29">33. As soon as, &amp;c. - Whereby we see the temper of
this people, who did no longer cleave to God, than they were in a manner
constrained to it, by the presence and authority of their Judges. Baalim
- This was the general name including all their idols, one of which here
follows. Baal-berith - That is, the Lord of the covenant; so called,
either from the covenant wherewith the worshippers of this God bound
themselves to maintain his worship, or to defend one another therein; or
rather, because he was reputed the God and judge of all covenants, and
promises, and contracts, to whom it belonged to maintain them, and to
punish the violaters of them; and such a God both the Grecians and the
Roman had.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="56.23%" prev="ii.viii.ix.ii" next="ii.viii.x.i" id="ii.viii.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges IX" id="ii.viii.x-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="56.23%" prev="ii.viii.x" next="ii.viii.x.ii" id="ii.viii.x.i">

<p id="ii.viii.x.i-p1">Abimelech usurps the government at Shechem, ver. 1-6.
Jotham's parable, ver. 7-21. Strife between Abimelech and the
Shechemites, ver. 22-41. The slaughter of the Shechemites, ver. 42-49.
The death of Abimelech, fulfilling Jotham's curse, ver. 50- 57.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="56.23%" prev="ii.viii.x.i" next="ii.viii.xi" id="ii.viii.x.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p1">2. Reign - He supposed they would take that government
which their father refused; and that the multitude of his sons would
occasion divisions, and confusions, which they might avoid by chusing
him king; and so they might enjoy the monarchy which they had long
desired. Your bone and flesh - Your kinsman, of the same tribe and city
with you; which will be no small honour and advantage to you.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p2">3. Brethren - That is, kinsmen. He is our brother - They
were easily persuaded to believe what served their own interest.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p3">4. Pieces of silver - Not shekels, which were too small a
sum for this purpose; but far larger pieces, the exact worth whereof it
is not possible for us now to know. The house of Baal-berith - Out of
his sacred treasury; having since Gideon's death built this temple
(which he would never have suffered whilst he lived) and endowed it with
considerable revenues. Light persons - Unsettled, idle and necessitous
persons, the proper instruments of tyranny and cruelty.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p4">5. His brethren -- the only persons who were likely to
hinder him in establishing his tyranny. Threescore and ten - Wanting
one, who is here expressed. Jotham was left - Whereby he would signify,
that this was an act of justice, in cutting them all off in an orderly
manner, for some supposed crime, probably, as designing sedition and
rebellion.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p5">6. House of Millo - Some eminent and potent family living
in Shechem, or near it. King - Over all Israel, ver. 22, which was a
strange presumption for the inhabitants of one city; but they had many
advantages for it; as the eager, and general, and constant inclination
of the Israelites to kingly government; Abimelech's being the son of
Gideon, to whom, and to his sons, they offered the kingdom. And though
the father could, and did refuse it for himself; yet they might imagine,
that he could not give away his sons' right, conveyed to them by the
Israelites, in their offer; the universal defection of the Israelites
from God to Baal, whose great patron and champion Abimelech pretended to
be; the power and prevalency of the tribe of Ephraim, in which Shechem
was, whose proud and imperious spirit, would make them readily close
with a king of their own brethren; and Abimelech's getting the start of
all others, having the crown actually put upon his head, and an army
already raised to maintain his tyranny. Of the pillar - Or, by the oak
of the pillar, by the oak, where Joshua erected a pillar as a witness of
the covenant renewed between God and Israel, <scripRef passage="Josh. xxiv. 26" id="ii.viii.x.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Josh|24|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.24.26">Josh.
xxiv, 26</scripRef>. This place they chose, to signify that they still owned
God, and their covenant with him; and did not worship Baal in opposition
to God, but in conjunction with him, or in subordination to him.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p6">7. Mount Gerizim - Which lay near Shechem. The valley
between Gerizim and Ebal, was a famous place, employed for the solemn
reading of the law, and its blessings and curses: and it is probable it
was still used, even by the superstitious and idolatrous Israelites for
such occasions, who delighted to use the same places which their
ancestors had used. Cried - So that they who stood in the valley might
hear him, though not suddenly come at him to take him. Men of Shechem -
Who were here met together upon a solemn occasion, as Josephus notes,
Abimelech being absent. That God may hearken - When you cry unto him for
mercy; so he conjures and persuades them to give him patient
audience.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p7">8. The trees, &amp;c. - A parabolical discourse, usual
among the ancients, especially in the eastern parts. To anoint - To make
a king, which was done among the Israelites, and some others, with the
ceremony of anointing. Olive-tree - By which he understands Gideon.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p8">9. honour God - In whose worship oil was used for divers
things; as, about the lamps, and offerings, and for anointing sacred
persons and things. And man - For oil was used in the constitution of
kings, and priests, and prophets, and for a present to great persons,
and to anoint the head and face. Promoted - Hebrew. to move hither and
thither, to wander to and fro, to exchange my sweet tranquility, for
incessant cares and travels.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p9">10. Fig-tree - Gideon refused this honour, both for
himself, and for his sons; and the sons of Gideon, whom Abimelech had
slain, upon pretense of their affecting the kingdom, were as far from
such thoughts as their father.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p10">13. Cheareth God - Wherewith God is well pleased, because
it was offered to God.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p11">14. Bramble - Or, thorn, fitly representing Abimelech,
the son of a concubine, and a person of small use, and great
cruelty.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p12">15. If in truth - If you deal truly and justly in making
me king. Then trust - Then you may expect protection under my
government. Devour the cedars - In stead of protection, you shall
receive destruction by me; especially you cedars, that is, nobles, such
as the house of Millo, who have been most forward in this work.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p13">18. Ye have slain - Abimelech's fact is justly charged
upon them, as done by their consent, approbation and assistance.
Maidservant - His concubine, whom he so calls by way of reproach. Over
Shechem - By which limitation of their power, and his kingdom, he
reflects contempt upon him, and chargeth them with presumption, that
having only power over their own city, they durst impose a king upon all
Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p14">20. Devour Abimelech - This is not so much a prediction
as an imprecation, which, being grounded upon just cause, had its
effect, as others in like case had.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p15">21. And fled - Which he might easily do, having the
advantage of the hill, and because the people were not forward to pursue
a man whom they knew to have such just cause to speak, and so little
power to do them hurt. To Beer - A place remote from Shechem, and out of
Abimelech's reach.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p16">22. Over Israel - For though the men of Shechem were the
first authors of Abimelech's advancement, the rest of the people easily
consented to that form of government which they so much desired.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p17">23. God sent - God gave the devil commission to work upon
their minds.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p18">24. The cruelty - That is, the punishment of the
cruelty.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p19">25. For him - To seize his person. Robbed all - Such as
favoured or served Abimelech; for to such only their commission reached,
though it may be, they went beyond their bounds, and robbed all
passengers promiscuously.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p20">26. Gaal - It is not known who he was; but it is evident,
he was a man very considerable for wealth, and strength and interest;
and ill-pleased with Abimelech's power. Went to Shechem - By his
presence and council to animate and assist them against Abimelech.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p21">27. Went out - Which, 'till his coming they durst not do,
for fear of Abimelech. Made merry - Both from the custom of rejoicing,
and singing songs in vintage time, and for the hopes of their redemption
from Abimelech's tyranny. Their goals-Baal-berith, ver. 4, either to beg
his help against Abimelech, or to give him thanks for the hopes of
recovering their liberty. Eat and drink - To the honour of their idols,
and out of the oblations made to them, as they used to do to the honour
of Jehovah, and out of his sacrifices. Cursed - Either by reviling him
after their manner, or, rather in a more solemn and religious manner,
cursing him by their God, as Goliath did David.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p22">28. Who is Abimelech - What is he but a base-born person,
a cruel tyrant, and one every way unworthy to govern you? Who is Shechem
- That is, Abimelech, named in the foregoing words, and described in
those which follow. He is called Shechem for the Shechemite. The sense
is, who is this Shechemite? For so he was by the mother's side, born of
a woman of your city, and she but his concubine and servant; why should
you submit to one so basely descended? Of Jerubbaal - Of Gideon, a
person famous only by his fierceness against that Baal which you justly
honour and reverence, whose altar he overthrew, and whose worship he
endeavoured to abolish. And Zebul - And you are so mean spirited, that
you do not only submit to him, but suffer his very servants to bear rule
over you; and particularly, this ignoble and hateful Zebul. Serve,
&amp;c. - If you love bondage, call in the old master and Lord of the
place; chuse not an upstart, as Abimelech is; but rather take one of the
old flock, one descended from Hamor, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxiv. 2" id="ii.viii.x.ii-p22.1" parsed="|Gen|34|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.34.2">Gen. xxxiv, 2</scripRef>, who did not carry himself like a tyrant, as Abimelech did;
but like a father of his city. This he might speak sincerely, as being
himself a Canaanite and Shechemite, and possibly came from one of those
little ones whom Simeon and Levi spared when they slew all the grown
males, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxiv. 29" id="ii.viii.x.ii-p22.2" parsed="|Gen|34|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.34.29">Gen. xxxiv, 29</scripRef>. And it may be that he was one of the royal blood, a
descendent of Hamor, who hereby sought to insinuate himself into the
government, as it follows, ver. 29. Would to God that this people were
under my hand; which he might judge the people more likely to chuse both
because they were now united with the Canaanites in religion; and
because their present distress might oblige them to put themselves under
him, a valiant and expert commander.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p23">29. My hand - That is, under my command; I wish you would
unanimously submit to me, as your captain and governor; for he found
them divided; and some of them hearkening after Abimelech, whom they had
lately rejected, according to the levity of the popular humour. I would
remove - As you have driven him out of your city, I would drive him out
of your country. He said - He sent this message or challenge to him.
Increase thine army - I desire not to surprise thee at any disadvantage;
strengthen thyself as much as thou canst, and come out into the open
field, that thou and I may decide it by our arms.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p24">35. And stood - To put his army in order, and to conduct
them against Abimelech, whom he supposed to be at a great distance.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p25">36. To Zebul - Who concealed the anger which he had
conceived, ver. 30, and pretended compliance with him in this
expedition, that he might draw him forth into the field where Abimelech
might have the opportunity of fighting with him, and overthrowing him.
The shadow - For in the morning, as this was, and in the evening, the
shadows are longest, and move quickest.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p26">38. Where is now, &amp;c. - Now shew thyself a man, and
fight valiantly for thyself and people.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p27">40. He fled - Being surprised by the unexpected coming of
Abimelech, and probably not fully prepared for the encounter.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p28">41. Dwelt at Arumah - He did not prosecute his victory,
but retreated to Arumah, to see whether the Shechemites would not of
themselves return to his government, or else, that being hereby grown
secure, he might have the greater advantage against them. Thrust out -
It seems the same night. Probably the multitude, which is generally
light and unstable, were now enraged against Gaal, suspecting him of
cowardice or ill-conduct. Zebul's interest was not so considerable with
them, that he could prevail with them either to kill Gaal and his
brethren, or to yield themselves to Abimelech; and therefore he still
complies with the people, and waits for a fairer opportunity.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p29">42. Went out - to their usual employments about their
land.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p30">43. Three companies - Whereof he kept one with himself,
ver. 44, and put the rest under other commanders.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p31">44. Entering of the gate - To prevent their retreat into
the city, and give the other two companies opportunity to cut them
off.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p32">45. With salt - In token of his desire of their utter and
irrecoverable destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p33">46. The tower - A strong place belonging to the city of
Shechem, made for its defense without the city. Berith - Or,
Baal-berith, ver. 4. Hither they fled out of the town belonging to it,
fearing the same event with Shechem; and here they thought to be secure;
partly by the strength of the place, partly by the religion of it,
thinking that either their God would protect them there, or that
Abimelech would spare them out of pity to that God.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p34">48. Zalmon - A place so called from its shadiness.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p35">50. Thebez - Another town near to Shechem; and, as it
seems, within its territory.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p36">51. And all - All that were not slain in the taking of
the town. Top of the tower - Which was flat and plain, after their
manner of building.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p37">53. Mill-stone - Such great stones no doubt they carried
up with them, whereby they might defend themselves, or offend those who
assaulted them. Here the justice of God is remarkable in suiting the
punishment to his sin. He slew his brethren upon a stone, ver. 5, and he
loseth his own life by a stone.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p38">54. A women - Which was esteemed a matter of
disgrace.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p39">56. Wickedness - In rooting out, as far as he could, the
name and memory of his father.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.x.ii-p40">57. Render upon their heads - Thus God preserved the
honour of his government, and gave warning to all ages, to expect blood
for blood.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="56.46%" prev="ii.viii.x.ii" next="ii.viii.xi.i" id="ii.viii.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges X" id="ii.viii.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="56.46%" prev="ii.viii.xi" next="ii.viii.xi.ii" id="ii.viii.xi.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xi.i-p1">The government of Tola and Jair, ver. 1-5. Israel's sin
and trouble, ver. 6-9. Their repentance and reformation, which found
acceptance with God, ver. 10-16. Preparation for their deliverance, ver.
17, 18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="56.46%" prev="ii.viii.xi.i" next="ii.viii.xii" id="ii.viii.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p1">1. There arose - Not of himself, but raised by God, as
the other Judges were. To defend - Or, to save, which he did not by
fighting against, and overthrowing their enemies, but by a prudent and
pious government of them, whereby he kept them from sedition,
oppression, and idolatry. In Shamir - Which was in the very midst of the
land.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p2">3. A Gileadite - Of Gilead beyond Jordan.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p3">4. And he had thirty sons - They were itinerant Judges,
who rode from place to place, as their father's deputies to administer
justice. Havoth-jair - These villages were called so before this time
from another Jair, but the old name was revived and confirmed upon this
occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p4">6. Forsook the Lord - They grew worse and worse, and so
ripened themselves for ruin. Before they worshipped God and idols
together, now they forsake God, and wholly cleave to idols.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p5">7. Philistines, &amp;c. - The one on the west, the other
on the east; so they were molested on both sides.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p6">8. That year - Or, that year they had vexed and oppressed
the children of Israel eighteen years - This was the eighteenth year
from the beginning of that oppression. And these eighteen years are not
to be reckoned from Jair's death, because that would enlarge the time of
the Judges beyond the just bounds; but from the fourth year of Jair's
reign: so that the greatest part of Jair's reign was contemporary with
this affliction. The case of Jair and Samson seem to be much alike. For
as it is said of Samson, that he judged Israel in the days of the
tyranny of the Philistines, twenty years, chap. xv, 20, by which it is
evident, that his judicature, and their dominion, were contemporary; the
like is to be conceived of Jair, that he began to judge Israel, and
endeavoured to reform religion, and purge out all abuses; but being
unable to effect this through the backwardness of the, people, God would
not enable him to deliver the people, but gave them up to this sad
oppression; so that Jair could only determine differences amongst the
Israelites, but could not deliver them from their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p7">10. And served also - Because not contented to add idols
to thee, we have preferred them before thee.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p8">11. The Lord said - Either by some prophet whom he raised
and sent for this purpose: or by the high-priest, who was consulted in
the case. From the Amorites - Both Sihon and Og, and their people, and
other kings of the Amorites within Jordan. Of Ammon - Who were
confederate with the Moabites, chap. iii, 13, 14.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p9">12. The Zidonians - We do not read of any oppression of
Israel, particularly, by the Zidonians. But many things were done, which
are not recorded. The Maonites - Either first, those who lived in, or
near the wilderness of Maon, in the south of Judah, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxiii. 25" id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|1Sam|23|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.23.25">1 Sam. xxiii, 25</scripRef>; xxv, 2, whether Edomites or others. Or, secondly, the
Mehunims, a people living near the Arabians, of whom, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxvi. 7" id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p9.2" parsed="|2Chr|26|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.26.7">2 Chron. xxvi, 7</scripRef>. For in the Hebrew, the letters of both names are the same,
only the one is the singular, the other the plural number.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p10">13. No more - Except you repent in another manner than
you yet have done; which when they performed, God suspended the
execution of this threatning.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p11">14. Chosen - You have not been forced to worship those
gods by your oppressors; but you have freely chosen them before me.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p12">15. Do thou unto us - Do not give us up into the hands of
these cruel men, but do thou chastise us with thine own hand as much as
thou pleasest; if we be not more faithful and constant to thee, than we
have hitherto been.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p13">16. They put away - This was an evidence of the sincerity
of their sorrow, that they did not only confess their sins, but also
forsake them. His soul, &amp;c. - He acted towards them, like one that
felt their sufferings; he had pity upon them, quite changed his carriage
towards them, and punished their enemies as sorely as if they had
grieved and injured his own person.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xi.ii-p14">17. Mizpeh - That Mizpeh which was beyond Jordan.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="56.53%" prev="ii.viii.xi.ii" next="ii.viii.xii.i" id="ii.viii.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XI" id="ii.viii.xii-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="56.53%" prev="ii.viii.xii" next="ii.viii.xii.ii" id="ii.viii.xii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xii.i-p1">The birth of Jephthah, rejected by his brethren, ver.
1-3. The Gileadites chuse him for their general, ver. 4-11. His treating
with the king of Ammon, ver. 12-28. His war with, and victory over the
Ammonites, ver. 29-33. His vow and the performance of it, ver.
34-40.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="56.53%" prev="ii.viii.xii.i" next="ii.viii.xiii" id="ii.viii.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p1">1. Gileadite - So called, either from his father Gilead,
or from the mountain, or city of Gilead, the place of his birth. Son of
a harlot - That is, a bastard. And though such were not ordinarily to
enter into the congregation of the Lord, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxiii. 2" id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Deut|23|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.23.2">Deut. xxiii, 2</scripRef>. Yet God can dispense with his own laws, and hath sometimes
done honour to base-born persons, so far, that some of them were
admitted to be the progenitors of the Lord Jesus Christ. And Gilead -
One of the children of that ancient Gilead, <scripRef passage="Num. xxxii. 1" id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Num|32|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.32.1">Num. xxxii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p2">3. Of Tob - The name either of the land, or of the man
who was the owner or ruler of it. This place was in, or near Gilead, as
appears by the speedy intercourse which here was between Jephthah and
the Israelites. Vain men - Idle persons, who desired rather to get their
living by spoil and rapine, than by honest labour. These evil persons
Jephthah managed well, employing them against the enemies of God, and of
Israel, that bordered upon them; and particularly upon parties of the
Ammonites, which made the Israelites more forward to chuse him for their
chieftain in this war. Went out - When he made excursions and attempts
upon the enemy.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p3">4. Made war - The Ammonites had vexed and oppressed them
eighteen years, and now the Israelites begin to make opposition, they
commence a war against them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p4">5. Went - By direction from God, who both qualified him
for, and called him to the office of a judge, otherwise they might not
have chosen a bastard.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p5">7. Expel me - And deprive me of all share in my father's
goods, which, though a bastard, was due to me. This expulsion of him was
the act of his brethren; but he here ascribes it to the elders of
Gilead; either because some of them were among these elders, as is very
probable from the dignity of this family; or because this act, though
desired by his brethren, was executed by the decree of the elders, to
whom the determination of all controversies about inheritance belonged;
and therefore it was their faults they did not protect him from the
injuries of his brethren.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p6">8. Therefore - Being sensible that we have done thee
injury, we come now to make thee full reparation.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p7">9. If, &amp;c. - If you recall me from this place where I
am now settled, to the place whence I was expelled. Shall I, &amp;c. -
Will you really make good this promise? Jephthah was so solicitous in
this case, either from his zeal for the public good, which required that
he should be so; or from the law of self-preservation, that he might
secure himself from his brethren; whose ill-will he had experienced, and
whose injuries he could not prevent, if, after he had served their ends,
he had been reduced to his private capacity.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p8">10. The Lord be witness - The Lord be an hearer: so the
Hebrew word is. Whatever we speak it concerns us to remember, that God
is an hearer!</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p9">11. All his words - Or, all his matters, the whole
business. Before the Lord - That is, before the public congregation,
wherewith God was usually, and then especially present.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p10">12. Messengers - That is, ambassadors, to prevent
blood-shed, that so the Israelites might be acquitted before God and
men, from all the sad consequences of this war; herein he shewed great
prudence, and no less piety. What hast thou, &amp;c. - What reasonable
cause hast thou for this invasion? In my land - He speaks this in the
name of all the people.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p11">13. My land - That is, this land of Gilead, which was
mine, but unjustly taken from me, by Sihon and Og, the kings of the
Ammonites; and the injury perpetuated by Israel's detaining it from me.
This land, before the conquests of Sihon and Og, belonged partly to the
Ammonites, and partly to the Moabites. And indeed, Moab and Ammon did
for the most part join their interests and their forces.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p12">16. The Red-sea - Unto which they came three times; once,
<scripRef passage="Exod. xiii. 18" id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Exod|13|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.13.18">Exod. xiii, 18</scripRef>, again, a little after their passage over it, and a third
time, long after, when they came to Ezion Geber, which was upon the
shore of the Red-Sea, from whence they went to Kadesh; of this time he
speaks here.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p13">17. Abode - Peaceably, and did not revenge their
unkindness as they could have done.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p14">19. My place - That is, unto the land of Canaan, which
God hath given me.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p15">20. Sihon fought - So Sihon was the aggressor, and the
Israelites were forced to fight in their own defense.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p16">22. The coasts - Or, borders; together with all the land
included within those borders. Wilderness - Namely, the desert of
Arabia.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p17">23. So the Lord - God, the sovereign Lord of all lands,
hath given us this land; this he adds, as a farther and convincing
reason; because otherwise it might have been alledged against the former
argument, that they could gain no more right to that land from Sihon,
than Sihon himself had.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p18">24. Wilt not thou - He speaks according to their absurd
opinion: the Ammonites and Moabites got their land by conquest of the
old inhabitants, whom they cast out; and this success, though given them
by the true God, for Lot's sake, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 9, 19" id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Deut|2|9|0|0;|Deut|2|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.9 Bible:Deut.2.19">Deut. ii, 9, 19</scripRef>, they impiously ascribe to their God Chemosh, whose gift
they owned to be a sufficient title.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p19">25. Than Balak - Art thou wiser than he? Or hast thou
more right than he had? Balak, though he plotted against Israel, in
defense of his own land, which he feared they would invade and conquer,
yet never contended with them about the restitution of those lands which
Sihon took from him or his predecessors.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p20">26. Three hundred years - Not precisely, but about that
time, either from their coming out of Egypt; or, from their first
conquest of those lands. He urges prescription, which is by all men
reckoned a just title, and it is fit it should be so for the good of the
world, because otherwise the door would be opened both to kings, and to
private persons, for infinite contentions and confusions.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p21">27. I have not - I have done thee no wrong. Be judge -
Let him determine this controversy by the success of this day and
war.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p22">29. Spirit came - Indued him with a more than ordinary
courage and resolution. Manasseh - That is, Bashan, which the half tribe
of Manasseh beyond Jordan inhabited. Mizpeh of Gilead - So called to
distinguish it from other cities of the same name, having gathered what
forces he suddenly could, he came hither to the borders of the
Ammonites.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p23">33. Minnith - A place not far from Rabbah, the chief city
of the Ammonites. Subdued before Israel - It does not appear, that he
offered to take possession of the country. Tho' the attempt of others to
wrong us, will justify us in the defense of our own right, yet it will
not authorize us to do them wrong.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p24">34. His daughter - In concert with other virgins, as the
manner was.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p25">35. Trouble me - Before this, I was troubled by my
brethren; and since, by the Ammonites; and now most of all, tho' but
occasionally, by thee. Opened my mouth - That is, I have vowed. Cannot
go back - That is, not retract my vow; I am indispensably obliged to
perform it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p26">36. Do to me - Do not for my sake make thyself a
transgressor; I freely give my consent to thy vow.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p27">37. Mountains - Which she chose as a solitary place, and
therefore fittest for lamentation. Bewail - That I shall die childless,
which was esteemed both a curse and a disgrace for the Israelites,
because such were excluded from that great privilege of increasing the
holy seed, and contributing to the birth of the Messiah.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p28">39. Did with her - Jephthah's daughter was not
sacrificed, but only devoted to perpetual virginity. This appears,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p29">1. From ver. 37, 38, where we read, that
she bewailed not her death, which had been the chief cause of
lamentation, if that had been vowed, but her virginity:</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p30">2. From this ver. 39, where, after he had
said, that he did with her according to his vow; he adds, by way of
declaration of the matter of that vow, and she knew no man. It is
probably conceived, that the Greeks, who used to steal sacred histories,
and turn them into fables, had from this history their relation of
Iphigenia (which may be put for Jephtigenia) sacrificed by her father
Agamemnon, which is described by many of the same circumstances
wherewith this is accompanied.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xii.ii-p31">40. The daughter of Jephthah - It is really astonishing,
that the general stream of commentators, should take it for granted,
that Jephthah murdered his daughter! But, says Mr. Henry, "We do not
find any law, usage or custom, in all the Old Testament, which doth in
the least intimate, that a single life was any branch or article of
religion." And do we find any law, usage or custom there, which doth in
the least intimate, that cutting the throat of an only child, was any
branch or article of religion? If only a dog had met Jephthah, would he
have offered up that for a burnt-offering? No: because God had expressly
forbidden this. And had he not expressly forbidden murder? But Mr. Poole
thinks the story of Agamemnon's offering up Iphigenia took its rise from
this. Probably it did. But then let it be observed, Iphigenia was not
murdered. Tradition said, that Diana sent an hind in her stead, and took
the maid to live in the woods with her.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="56.69%" prev="ii.viii.xii.ii" next="ii.viii.xiii.i" id="ii.viii.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XII" id="ii.viii.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="56.69%" prev="ii.viii.xiii" next="ii.viii.xiii.ii" id="ii.viii.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xiii.i-p1">Jephthah's encounter with, and slaughter of the
Ephraimites, ver. 1-6. His death, ver. 7 A short account of three other
Judges ver. 8-15.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="56.70%" prev="ii.viii.xiii.i" next="ii.viii.xiv" id="ii.viii.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xiii.ii-p1">1. Northward - Over Jordan, where Jephthah was, in the
northern part of the land beyond Jordan. And said - Through pride and
envy, contending with him as they did before with Gideon. Over - Not
over Jordan, for there he was already; but over the borders of the
Israelites land beyond Jordan.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiii.ii-p2">2. When I called - Hence it appears, that he had craved
their assistance, which they had denied; though that be not elsewhere
expressed.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiii.ii-p3">3. Put my life - That is, I exposed myself to the utmost
danger; as a man that carries a brittle and precious thing in his hand,
which may easily either fall to the ground, or be snatched from him.
Wherefore - Why do you thus requite my kindness in running such hazards
to preserve you and yours?</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiii.ii-p4">4. Ye Gileadites - These words are a contemptuous
expression of the Ephraimites concerning the Gileadites, whom they call
fugitives of Ephraim; the word Ephraim being here taken largely, as it
comprehends the other neighbouring tribes, of which Ephraim was the
chief; and especially their brethren of Manasseh, who lived next to
them, and were descended from the same father, Joseph. By Gileadites
here they seem principally to mean the Manassites beyond Jordan, who
dwelt in Gilead. And although other Gileadites were joined with them,
yet they vent their passion against these; principally, because they
envied them most; as having had a chief hand in the victory. These they
opprobriously call fugitives, that is, such as had deserted their
brethren of Ephraim and Manasseh, planted themselves beyond Jordan, at a
distance from their brethren, and were alienated in affection from
them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiii.ii-p5">5. Said Nay - To avoid the present danger.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiii.ii-p6">6. Shibboleth - Which signifies a stream or river, which
they desired to pass over: so it was a word proper for the occasion, and
gave them no cause to suspect the design, because they were required
only to express their desire to go over the Shibboleth or river.
Sibboleth - It is well known, that not only divers nations, but divers
provinces, or parts of the same nation who use the same language, differ
in their manner of pronunciation. Could not frame - Or rather, he did
not frame to speak right; so as he was required to do it. The Hebrew
text doth not say, that he could not do it, but that he did it not,
because suspecting not the design he uttered it speedily according to
his manner of expression. There fell - Not in that place, but in that
expedition, being slain either in the battle, or in the pursuit, or at
Jordan. See the justice of God! They had gloried, that they were
Ephraimites: But how soon are they afraid to own their country? They had
called the Gileadites, fugitives: And now they are in good earnest
become fugitives themselves. It is the same word, ver. 5, used of the
Ephraimites that fled, which they had used in scorn of the Gileadites.
He that rolls the stone, or reproach unjustly on another, it may justly
return upon himself.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiii.ii-p7">9. Took in - That is, took them home for wives to his
sons. What a difference between his and his predecessor's family! Ibzan
had sixty children, and all married: Jephthah but one, and she dies
unmarried. Some are increased, others diminished: all is the Lord's
doing.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiii.ii-p8">15. Mount of the Amalekites - So called from some
remarkable exploit, done by, or upon the Amalekites in that place. It is
strange, that in the history of all these Judges, there is not so much
as once mention of the high-priest, or of any other priest or Levite,
appearing either for council or action in any public affair, from
Phinehas to Eli, which may well be computed two hundred and fifty years!
Surely this intimates, that the institution was chiefly intended to be
typical, and that the benefits which were promised by it, were to be
chiefly looked for in its anti-type, the everlasting priesthood of
Christ, in comparison of which that priesthood had no glory.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="56.76%" prev="ii.viii.xiii.ii" next="ii.viii.xiv.i" id="ii.viii.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XIII" id="ii.viii.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="56.76%" prev="ii.viii.xiv" next="ii.viii.xiv.ii" id="ii.viii.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.i-p1">Samson was an eminent believer, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 13, 32" id="ii.viii.xiv.i-p1.1" parsed="|Heb|11|13|0|0;|Heb|11|32|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.13 Bible:Heb.11.32">Heb. xi, 13, 32</scripRef>, and a glorious type of him who with his own arm wrought
salvation. The occasion of raising him up, ver. 1. His birth foretold by
an angel, ver. 2-5. His mother relates this to his father, ver. 6, 7.
The angel repeats it to them both, ver. 8-14. Manoah offers to entertain
him and asks his name, ver. 15-18. He discovers himself at parting, ver.
19-23. Samson is born, ver. 24, 25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="56.77%" prev="ii.viii.xiv.i" next="ii.viii.xv" id="ii.viii.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p1">1. Did evil - That is, fell into idolatry, not after the
death of Abdon the last judge, but in the days of the former Judges.
Forty years - To be computed, not from Abdon's death, but before that
time. And it is probable that great slaughter of the Ephraimites made by
Jephthah, greatly encouraged the Philistines to rise against Israel,
when one of their chief bulwarks was so much weakened; and therefore
began to domineer over them not long after Jephthah's death. These were
a very inconsiderable people. They had but five cities of any note. And
yet when God used them as the staff in his hand, they were very
oppressive and vexatious.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p2">2. Of the family - That is, of the tribe or people. Bare
not - An emphatical repetition of the same thing in other words, which
is an usual elegancy both in scripture and other authors.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p3">3. The angel - The Son of God, yet distinguished from the
Lord, because he appeared here in the form of a servant, as a messenger
sent from God. The great Redeemer did in a particular manner concern
himself about this typical redeemer.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p4">4. Beware - Because the child was to be a Nazarite from
the womb, ver. 5, and from the conception; and because the mother's
pollution extends to the child, she is enjoined from this time to
observe the following rules belonging to the Nazarites. Strong drink -
Under which are comprehended the other particulars mentioned, <scripRef passage="Num. vi. 2-4" id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Num|6|2|6|4" osisRef="Bible:Num.6.2-Num.6.4">Num. vi, 2-4</scripRef>. Nor eat - Any of those meats forbidden, <scripRef passage="Levit xi. 1-47" id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p4.2" parsed="|Lev|11|1|11|47" osisRef="Bible:Lev.11.1-Lev.11.47">Levit xi, 1-47</scripRef>, which were forbidden to all, but especially to the
Nazarites.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p5">5. A Nazarite - A person consecrated to God's service.
Begin to deliver - And the deliverance shall be carried on and perfected
by others, as it was by Eli, Samuel, and Saul; but especially by David.
God chuses to carry on his work gradually and by several hands. One lays
the foundation of a good work, another builds, and perhaps a third
brings forth the top stone.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p6">6. Man of God - A prophet, or sacred person, sent with a
message from God. Terrible - Or, venerable, awful, full of Majesty.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p7">12. Let thy words - Or, thy words shall come to pass: I
firmly believe thy promises shall be fulfilled. How - What rules shall
we observe about his education?</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p8">13. Let her - Whilst the child is in her womb, and after
the child is born let him observe the same orders.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p9">15. Made ready - Supposing him to be a man and a prophet,
to whom he would in this manner express his respect, as was usual to
strangers.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p10">16. Bread - That is, meat, as bread is commonly taken in
scripture. To the Lord - Not unto a man, as thou apprehendest me to be;
but unto the Lord, as thou wilt by and by perceive me to be.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p11">17. honour - Either by making honourable mention of thee,
or by shewing respect to thee, by a present, which they usually gave to
prophets.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p12">18. Secret - Hidden from mortal men: or, wonderful, such
as thou canst not comprehend: my nature and essence, (which is often
signified by name in scripture) is incomprehensible. This shews, that
this was the angel of the covenant, the Son of God.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p13">19. Meal-offering - Which were generally joined with the
chief sacrifices. A Rock - The angel's presence and command being a
sufficient warrant for the offering of sacrifice by a person who was no
priest, and in a place otherwise forbidden.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p14">20. The altar - That is, from that part of the rock which
served instead of an altar, upon which the sacrifice was laid. Ascended
- To manifest his nature and essence to be spiritual. Fell - Partly in
reverence to that glorious presence manifested in so wonderful a manner:
and partly, out of a religious horror and fear of death; for the
prevention thereof they fell down in way of supplication to God.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p15">23. Nor would, &amp;c. - This expression seems to have
some emphasis in it, to enhance God's mercy to them, as being afforded
them in a time of such grievous calamity; and in a time when the word of
the Lord was precious; and there was no open vision.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p16">24. Blessed him - That is, endowed him with all those
graces and gifts of mind and body which were necessary for the work he
was designed for.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xiv.ii-p17">25. To move - That is, to stir him up to heroical
designs; to shew forth its power in the frame of his mind, and in the
strength of his body, discovered to his neighbours in extraordinary
actions; to encline his heart to great attempts for the help and
deliverance of God's people, to give some essays of it to his brethren,
and to seek all opportunities for it. Of Daniel - A place so called,
either from the expedition of the Danites, chap. xviii, 11, 12, which
though placed after this history, was done before it: or from some other
camp which the Danites had formed there, to give some check to the
incursions of the Philistines.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="56.85%" prev="ii.viii.xiv.ii" next="ii.viii.xv.i" id="ii.viii.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XIV" id="ii.viii.xv-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="56.85%" prev="ii.viii.xv" next="ii.viii.xv.ii" id="ii.viii.xv.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xv.i-p1">Samson's marriage with a Philistine, and killing a lion,
ver. 1-7. He finds honey in the carcase, ver. 8, 9. His riddle, ver. 10-
14. Unriddled by means of his wife, ver. 15-18. He kills thirty
Philistines, and leaves her, ver. 19,</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="56.86%" prev="ii.viii.xv.i" next="ii.viii.xvi" id="ii.viii.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p1">1. Went - After he was come to mature age. Timnath - A
place not far from the sea.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p2">2. To wife - Herein he is an example to all children,
conformable to the fifth commandment. Children ought not to marry, nor
to move toward it without the advice and consent of their parents. They
that do, as Bishop Hall speaks, unchild themselves. Parents have a
property in their children, as parts of themselves. In marriage this
property is transferred. It is therefore not only unkind and ungrateful,
but palpably unjust, to alienate this property, without their
concurrence. Who so thus robbeth his father or mother, stealing himself
from them who is nearer and dearer to them than their goods, and yet
saith, It is no transgression, the same is the companion of a destroyer,
<scripRef passage="Prov. xxviii. 24" id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Prov|28|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.28.24">Prov. xxviii, 24</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p3">3. Philistines - With whom the Israelites were forbidden
to marry. For although the Philistines were not Canaanites in their
original, yet they were so in their concurrence with them in wickedness,
and therefore were liable to the same judgments with them. Get her -
This action of Samson's, though against common rules, seems to be
warranted, by the direction of God, (mentioned in the following words)
which was known to Samson, but not to his parents. Pleaseth me - Not so
much for her beauty, as for the design mentioned in the next verse.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p4">5. Father and mother - Who accompanied him, either
because they were now acquainted with his design; or, to order the
circumstances of that action which they saw he was set upon.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p5">6. Came mightily - Increased his courage and bodily
strength. A kid - As soon and as safely. Told not, &amp;c. - Lest by
their means it should be publickly known; for he wisely considered, that
it was not yet a fit time to awaken the jealousies and fears of the
Philistines concerning him, as this would have done.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p6">8. After a time - Hebrew. after days; that is, either
after some days: or, rather, after a year, as that word often signifies;
when the flesh of the lion, (which by its strong smell is offensive to
bees) was wholly consumed, and nothing was left but the bones. Bees -
Settling themselves there, as they have sometimes done in a man's skull,
or in a sepulchre.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p7">9. Came to, &amp;c. - From whom he had turned aside for a
season, ver. 8.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p8">11. Saw him - Or, observed him, his stature, and
strength, and countenance, and carriage, which were extraordinary.
Brought - Partly in compliance with the custom of having bride-men;
though they were not so numerous; but principally by way of caution, and
as a guard put upon him under a pretense of respect and affection.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p9">12. Seven days - For so long marriage-feasts lasted.
Sheets - Fine linen-clothes, which were used for many purposes in those
parts. Changes - Suits of apparel.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p10">15. Seventh day - They had doubtless spoken to her before
this time, but with some remissness, supposing that they should find it
out; but now their time being nigh slipped, they put her under a
necessity of searching it out. To take that we have - That is, to strip
us of our garments.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p11">17. The seven days - That is, on the residue of the seven
days; namely, after the third day.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p12">18. If ye had not &amp;c. - If you had not employed my
wife to find it out, as men plough up the ground with an heifer, thereby
discovering its hidden parts; he calls her heifer, because she was
joined with him in the same yoke.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p13">19. The spirit came - Though he had constant strength and
courage; yet that was exceedingly increased upon special occasions, by
the extraordinary influences of God's spirit. To Ashkelon - Either to
the territory; or to the city itself, where he had both strength and
courage enough to attempt what follows; and upon the doing hereof they
were doubtless struck with such terror, that every one sought only to
preserve himself, and none durst pursue him. His anger was kindled - For
the treachery of his wife and companions. He went - Without his wife. It
were well for us, if the unkindnesses we meet with from the world, and
our disappointments therein has this good effect on us, to oblige us to
return by faith and prayer, to our heavenly father's house.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xv.ii-p14">20. Was given - By her father. Whom he had used - That
is, to the chief of the bride-men, to whom he had shewed most respect
and kindness.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="56.93%" prev="ii.viii.xv.ii" next="ii.viii.xvi.i" id="ii.viii.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XV" id="ii.viii.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="56.93%" prev="ii.viii.xvi" next="ii.viii.xvi.ii" id="ii.viii.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.i-p1">From the treachery of his wife and her father, Samson
takes occasion to burn their corn, ver. 1-5. He smites the Philistines
with a great slaughter, ver. 6-8. He slays a thousand of them with the
jaw-bone of an ass, ver. 9-17. He is distressed, and supplied with
water, ver. 18-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="56.94%" prev="ii.viii.xvi.i" next="ii.viii.xvii" id="ii.viii.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p1">1. Wheat harvest - Which was the proper season for what
follows. With a kid - As a token of reconciliation. Into the chamber -
Into her chamber, which the women had separate from the mens.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p2">2. Hated her - Because thou didst desert her: but this
was no sufficient cause; for he should have endeavoured a
reconciliation, and not have disposed of another man's wife without his
consent.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p3">3. Now shall I, &amp;c. - Because they have first
provoked me by an irreparable injury: but although this may look like an
act of private revenge; yet it is plain Samson acted as a judge (for so
he was) and as an avenger of the publick injuries of his people.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p4">4. Foxes - Of which there were great numbers in Canaan.
But it is not said that Samson caught them all, either at one time, or
by his own hands; for being so eminent a person, and the judge of
Israel, he might require assistance of as many persons as he pleased.
And it must be allowed, that the God who made the world, and by his
singular providence watched over Israel, and intended them deliverance
at this time, could easily dispose things so that they might be taken.
He chose to do this not by his brethren, whom he would preserve from the
hatred and mischief which it might have occasioned them, but by brute
creatures, thereby to add scorn to their calamity, and particularly by
foxes; partly, because they were fittest for the purpose, being
creatures very fearful of fire; and having such tails as the fire-brands
might most conveniently be tied to; and not going directly forward, but
crookedly, whereby the fire would be dispersed in more places.
Fire-brands - Made of such matter as would quickly take fire, and keep
it for a long time; which was easy to procure. And put, &amp;c. - That
the foxes might not make too much haste, nor run into their holes, but
one of them might delay another, and so continue longer in the places
where they were to do execution.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p5">5. Let them go - Successively at several times; and in
divers places, so that they might not hinder one another, nor all run
into the same field; but being dispersed in all parts, might spread the
plague farther; and withal might be kept at a distance from the fields
and vineyards of the Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p6">6. Burnt her - For the mischief which she had occasioned
them; thus she brought upon herself that mischief which she studied to
avoid. The Philistines had threatened to burn her and her father's house
with fire. To avoid this she betrayed her husband. And now the very
thing she feared comes upon her!</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p7">8. Hip and thigh - It seems to be a phrase, to express a
desperate attack, attended with the utmost hurry and confusion: and
perhaps intimates, that they all fled before him. So he smote them in
the hinder parts. Rock Etam - A natural fortress, where he waited to see
what steps the Philistines would take.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p8">11. Unto us - Thou hast by these actions punished not
them only, but us, who are sure to smart for it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p9">12. Bind thee - Why not rather, to fight under thy
banner? Because sin dispirits men, nay, it infatuates them, and hides
from their eyes the things that belong to their peace. Swear - Not that
he feared them, or could not as easily have conquered them, as he did
the host of the Philistines; but because he would be free from all
temptation of doing them harm, though it were in his own defense.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p10">13. And they bound him - Thus was he a type of Christ,
who yielded himself to be bound, yea and led as a lamb to the slaughter.
Never were men so besotted as these men of Judah, except those who thus
treated our blessed saviour. The rock - That is, from the cave in the
rock, in which he had secured himself, out of which he was first brought
up, and then carried down from the rock to the plain.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p11">14. Shouted - Because they had now their enemy, as they
supposed, in their hands. Loosed - Hebrew. were melted; that is, were
dissolved, as things which are melted in the fire. This typified the
resurrection of Christ, by the power of the Spirit of holiness. In this
he loosed the bands of death, it being impossible he should be holden of
them. And thus he triumphed over the powers of darkness, which had
shouted against him.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p12">15. New jaw-bone - And therefore the more tough and
strong.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p13">16. Slain a thousand men - What could be too hard for him
to do, on whom the Spirit of the Lord came mightily? It was strange the
men of Judah did now at least come in to his assistance. But he was to
be a type of him, who trod the wine-press alone.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p14">17. Ramath-Lehi - That is, the lifting up of the
jaw-bone; by contraction Lehi, ver. 14, as Salem is put for
Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p15">18. Sore a thirst - A natural effect of the great pains
he had taken. And perhaps there was the hand of God therein, to chastise
him for not making mention of God in his song, and to keep him from
being proud of his strength. One would have thought that the men of
Judah would have met him with bread and wine: but they so little
regarded him, that he is fainting for want of a draught of water! Thus
are the greatest slights often put upon those that do the greatest
services! Shall I die - Wilt thou not finish what thou hast begun? Wilt
thou undo what thou hast done.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p16">19. In the Jaw - Either causing the jaw-bone to send
forth water, as the rock formerly did, causing a spring to break forth
in that Lehi, mentioned ver. 14, for Lehi is both the name of a place,
and a jaw-bone. En-hakkore - That is, the fountain of him that cried for
thirst; or, that called upon God for deliverance; that is, the fountain
which was given in answer to my prayer. In Lehi - According to this
translation, Lehi is the name of a place.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvi.ii-p17">20. He judged - That is, he pleaded their cause, and
avenged them against the Philistines. Of the Philistines - That is,
whilst the Philistines had the power and dominion, from which he was not
fully to deliver, but only to begin to deliver them. From this place it
is manifest, that in the computation of the times of the Judges, the
years of servitude or oppression are not to be separated from the years
of the Judges, but added to them, and are comprehended within them;
which proposition is of great importance for clearing this difficult
part of scripture-chronology.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="57.05%" prev="ii.viii.xvi.ii" next="ii.viii.xvii.i" id="ii.viii.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XVI" id="ii.viii.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="57.05%" prev="ii.viii.xvii" next="ii.viii.xvii.ii" id="ii.viii.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.i-p1">Samson is greatly endangered by his intercourse with an
harlot, ver. 1-3. Betrayed by Delilah to the Philistines thrice, ver.
4-14. Weakened and effectually betrayed, ver. 15-20. Seized, blinded,
bound, imprisoned and made sport of, ver. 21-25. Avenged of the
Philistines, ver. 26-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="57.05%" prev="ii.viii.xvii.i" next="ii.viii.xviii" id="ii.viii.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p1">1. And saw - Going into an house of publick entertainment
to refresh himself. He there saw this harlot accidentally; and by giving
way to look upon her, was ensnared, <scripRef passage="Gen. iii. 6" id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|3|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.3.6">Gen. iii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p2">2. In the morning - This they chose to do, rather than to
seize upon him in his bed by night; either, because they knew not
certainly in what house he was; or, because they thought that might
cause great terror, and confusion, and mischief among their own people;
whereas in the day-time they might more fully discover him, and more
certainly use their weapons against him. O that all who indulge any
unholy desire, might see themselves thus surrounded, and marked for
destruction by their spiritual enemies! The more secure they are, the
greater is their danger.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p3">3. Arose - Perhaps warned by God in a dream; or rather by
the checks of his own conscience. Went away - The watch-men not
expecting him 'till morning, and therefore being now retired into the
sides, or upper part of the gate-house, as the manner now is, to get
some rest, to fit themselves for their hard service intended in the
morning: nor durst they pursue him, whom they now again perceived to
have such prodigious strength, and courage; and to be so much above the
fear of them, that he did not run away with all speed, but went
leisurely. Hebron - Which was above twenty miles from Gaza. And Samson
did this not out of vain ostentation, but as an evidence of his great
strength, for the encouragement of its people to join with him
vigourously; and for the greater terror and contempt of the Philistines.
It may seem strange that Samson immediately after so foul a sin should
have courage and strength from God, for so great a work. But first, it
is probable, that Samson had in some measure repented of his sin, and
begged of God pardon and assistance. 2.This singular strength and
courage was not in itself a grace, but a gift, and it was such a gift as
did not so much depend on the disposition of his mind, but on the right
ordering of his body, by the rule given to him, and others of that
order.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p4">4. Loved - Probably as an harlot: because the dreadful
punishment now inflicted upon Samson for this sin, whom God spared for
the first offense, is an intimation, that this sin was not inferior to
the former.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p5">5. The lords - The lords of their five principal cities,
who were leagued together against him as their common enemy. Afflict -
To chastise him for his injuries done to us. They mean to punish him
severely, but they express it in mild words, lest it might move her to
pity him. Pieces of silver - Shekels, as that phrase is commonly
used.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p6">7. Samson said - Samson is guilty both of the sin of
lying, and of great folly in encouraging her enquiries, which he should
at first have checked: but as he had forsaken God, so God had now
forsaken him, otherwise the frequent repetition and vehement urging of
this question might easily have raised suspicion in him.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p7">9. With her - That is, in a secret chamber within her
call. Nor is it strange that they did not fall upon him in his sleep,
because they expected an opportunity for doing their work more
certainly, and with less danger.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p8">13. Web - Or, thread which is woven about a weaver's
loom: or, with a weaver's beam. If my hair, which is all divided into
seven locks, be fastened about a weaver's beam; or interwoven with
weaver's threads: then I shall be weak as another man.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p9">15. Not with me - Not open to me.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p10">16. Vexed - Being tormented by two contrary passions,
desire to gratify her, and fear of betraying himself. So that he had no
pleasure of his life.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p11">17. If I be shaven - Not that his hair was in itself the
cause of his strength, but because it was the chief condition of that
covenant, whereby God was pleased to ingage himself to fit him for, and
assist him in that great work to which he called him: but upon his
violation of the condition, God justly withdraws his help. (EFN <scripRef passage="Isaiah xl. 31" id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Isa|40|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.40.31">Isaiah xl, 31</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Psalm xxix. 11" id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p11.2" parsed="|Ps|29|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.29.11">Psalm xxix, 11</scripRef>)</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p12">18. And brought money in their hand - See one of the
bravest men then in the world bought and sold, as a sheep for the
slaughter. How does this instance sully all the glory of man, and forbid
the strong man ever to boast of his strength!</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p13">19. Sleep - By some sleepy potion. Knees - Resting his
head upon her knees. To weaken or hurt, tho' he felt it not.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p14">20. Said - Within himself. Shake myself - That is, put
forth my strength. Knew not - Not distinctly feeling the loss of his
hair, or not considering what would follow. Many have lost the
favourable presence of God, and are not aware of it. They have provoked
God to withdraw from them; but are not sensible of their loss.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p15">21. His eyes - Which was done both out of revenge and
policy, to disable him from doing them harm, in case he should recover
his strength; but not without God's providence, punishing him in that
part which had been instrumental to his sinful lusts. Gaza - Because
this was a great and strong city, where he would be kept safely; and
upon the sea-coast, at sufficient distance from Samson's people; and to
repair the honour of that place, upon which he had fastened so great a
scorn. God also ordering things thus, that where he first sinned, ver.
1, there he should receive his punishment. Grind - As slaves use to do.
He made himself a slave to harlots, and now God suffers men to use him
like a slave. Poor Samson, how art thou fallen! How is thine honour laid
in the dust! Wo unto him, for he hath sinned! Let all take warning by
him, carefully to preserve their purity. For all our glory is gone, when
the covenant of our separation to God, as spiritual Nazarites, is
profaned.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p16">22. The hair - This circumstance, though in itself
inconsiderable, is noted as a sign of the recovery of God's favour, and
his former strength, in some degree, upon his repentance, and renewing
his vow with God, which was allowed for Nazarites to do.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p17">23. Dagon - An idol, whose upper part was like a man, and
whose lower part was like a fish: probably one of the sea-gods of the
Heathens.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p18">25. Made sport - Either being made by them the matter of
their sport and derision, of bitter scoffs, and other indignities: or,
by some proofs of more than ordinary strength yet remaining in him, like
the ruins of a great and goodly building: whereby he lulled them asleep,
until by this complaisance he prepared the way for that which he
designed.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p19">26. Whereon the house standeth-Whether it were a temple,
or theatre, or some slight building run up for the purpose.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p20">27. The roof - Which was flat, and had window's through
which they might see what was done in the lower parts of the house.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p21">28. Samson called - This prayer was not an act of malice
and revenge, but of faith and zeal for God, who was there publickly
dishonoured; and justice, in vindicating the whole common- wealth of
Israel, which was his duty, as he was judge. And God, who heareth not
sinners, and would never use his omnipotence to gratify any man's
malice, did manifest by the effect, that he accepted and owned his
prayer as the dictate of his own Spirit. And that in this prayer he
mentions only his personal injury, and not their indignities to God and
his people, must be ascribed to that prudent care which he had, upon
former occasions, of deriving the rage of the Philistines upon himself
alone, and diverting it from the people. For which end I conceive this
prayer was made with an audible voice, though he knew they would
entertain it only with scorn and laughter.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p22">30. Two pillars - Instances are not wanting of more
capacious buildings than this, that have been supported only by one
pillar. Pliny in the 15th chapter of the 36th Book of his Natural
History, mentions two theatres built by C. Curio, in Julius Caesar's
time; each of which was supported only by one pillar, tho' many
thousands of people sat in it together. Let me die - That is, I am
content to die, so I can but contribute to the vindication of God's
glory, and the deliverance of God's people. This is no encouragement to
those who wickedly murder themselves: for Samson did not desire, or
procure his own death voluntarily, but by mere necessity; he was by his
office obliged to seek the destruction of these enemies and blasphemers
of God, and oppressors of his people; which in these circumstances he
could not effect without his own death. Moreover, Samson did this by
Divine direction, as God's answer to his prayer manifests, and that he
might be a type of Christ, who by voluntarily undergoing death,
destroyed the enemies of God, and of his people. They died, just when
they were insulting over an Israelite, persecuting him whom God had
smitten. Nothing fills up the measure of the iniquity of any person or
people faster, than mocking or misusing the servants of God, yea, tho'
it is by their own folly, that they are brought low. Those know not what
they do, nor whom they affront, that make sport with a good man.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xvii.ii-p23">31. Buried - While the Philistines were under such grief,
and consternation, that they had neither heart nor leisure to hinder
them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="57.21%" prev="ii.viii.xvii.ii" next="ii.viii.xviii.i" id="ii.viii.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XVII" id="ii.viii.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="57.21%" prev="ii.viii.xviii" next="ii.viii.xviii.ii" id="ii.viii.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.i-p1">Micah provides an image for his God, ver. 1-6. And a
Levite for his priest, ver. 7-13.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="57.21%" prev="ii.viii.xviii.i" next="ii.viii.xix" id="ii.viii.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p1">1. There was, &amp;c. - The things mentioned here, and in
the following chapters, did not happen in the order in which they are
put; but much sooner, even presently after the death of the elders that
over-lived Joshua, as appears, because Phinehas the son of Eleazar was
priest at this time, chap. xx, 28, who must have been about 350 years
old, if this had been done after Samson's death.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p2">2. Cursedst - That is, didst curse the person who had
taken them away. I took it - The fear of thy curse makes me acknowledge
mine offense, and beg thy pardon. Blessed - I willingly consent to, and
beg from God the removal of the curse, and a blessing instead of it. Be
thou free from my curse, because thou hast so honestly restored it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p3">3. The Lord - In the Hebrew it is, Jehovah, the
incommunicable name of God. Whereby it is apparent, that neither she,
nor her son, intended to forsake the true God; as appears from his
rejoicing when he had got a priest of the Lord's appointment, but only
to worship God by an image; which also both the Israelites, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxii. 1" id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Exod|32|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.32.1">Exod. xxxii, 1</scripRef>, &amp;c. and Jeroboam afterwards, designed to do. For my son
- For the benefit of thyself and family; that you need not be
continually going to Shiloh to worship, but may do it at home. To thee -
To dispose of, as I say.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p4">4. Restored - Though his mother allowed him to keep it,
yet he persisted in his resolution to restore it, that she might dispose
of it as she pleased. Two hundred - Reserving nine hundred shekels,
either for the ephod or teraphim, or for other things relating to this
worship.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p5">5. Of gods - That is, an house consecrated for the
service of God in this manner. Teraphim - A sort of images so called.
One of his sons - Because the Levites in that corrupt estate of the
church, neglected the exercise of their office, and therefore they were
neglected by the people, and others put into their employment.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p6">6. No king - No judge to govern and control them. The
word king being used largely for a supreme magistrate. God raised up
Judges to rule and deliver the people, when he saw fit; and at other
times for their sins he suffered them to be without them, and such a
time this was; and therefore they ran into that idolatry, from which the
Judges usually kept them; as appears by that solemn and oft- repeated
passage in this book, that after the death of such or such a judge, the
people forsook the Lord, and turned to idols. His own eyes - That is,
not what pleased God, but what best suited his own fancy.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p7">7. Bethlehem-judah - So called here, as <scripRef passage="Matt. ii. 1, 5" id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Matt|2|1|0|0;|Matt|2|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.2.1 Bible:Matt.2.5">Matt. ii, 1, 5</scripRef>, to difference it from Bethlehem in Zebulun. There he was
born and bred. Of Judah - That is, of or belonging to the tribe of
Judah; not by birth, for he was a Levite; but by his habitation and
ministration. For the Levites were dispersed among all the tribes; and
this man's lot fell into the tribe of Judah. Sojourned - So he
expresseth it, because this was not the proper place of his abode, this
being no Levitical city.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p8">8. To sojourn - For employment and a livelihood; for the
tithes and offerings, which were their maintenance, not being brought
into the house of God, the Levites and priests were reduced to
straights.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p9">10. A father - That is, a priest, a spiritual father, a
teacher or instructor. He pretends reverence and submission to him; and
what is wanting in his wages, he pays him in titles.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p10">11. Content - Being infected with the common superstition
and idolatry of the times. His sons - That is, treated with the same
degree of kindness and affection.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p11">12. Consecrated - To be a priest, for which he thought a
consecration necessary, as knowing the Levites were no less excluded
from the priest's office than the people. The young man - Instead of his
son, whom he had consecrated, but now seems to restrain him from the
exercise of that office, and to devolve it wholly upon the Levite, who
was nearer akin to it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xviii.ii-p12">13. Do me good - I am assured God will bless me. So blind
and grossly partial he was in his judgment, to think that one right
circumstance would answer for all his substantial errors, in making and
worshipping images against God's express command, in worshipping God in
a forbidden place, by a priest illegally appointed.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="57.29%" prev="ii.viii.xviii.ii" next="ii.viii.xix.i" id="ii.viii.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XVIII" id="ii.viii.xix-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="57.29%" prev="ii.viii.xix" next="ii.viii.xix.ii" id="ii.viii.xix.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xix.i-p1">The Danish spies call at Micah's house, ver. 1-6. The
report they bring back, ver. 7-10. The Danites send forces, who by the
way plunder Micah of his gods, ver. 11-26. They take Laish and set up
idolatry there, ver. 27-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="57.29%" prev="ii.viii.xix.i" next="ii.viii.xx" id="ii.viii.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p1">1. Those days - Not long after Joshua's death. The tribe
- A part of that tribe, consisting only of six hundred men of war, with
their families, ver. 16, 21. Inheritance - The lot had fallen to them
before this time, but not the actual possession, because the Philistines
and Amorites opposed them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p2">2. There - Not in the same house, but near it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p3">3. Knew - By the acquaintance which some of them formerly
had with him.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p4">5. Ask - By thine Ephod, and Teraphim, or images, which
they knew he had, ver. 14.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p5">6. Before the Lord - That is, your design is under the
eye of God; that is, under his care, protection and direction. This
answer he either feigns to gratify their humour; or, did indeed receive
from the devil, who transformed himself into an angel of light, and in
God's name gave him answers, and those not sometimes very true, which
God suffered for the trial of his people. But it is observable, his
answer was, as the devil's oracles usually were, ambiguous, and such as
might have been interpreted either way.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p6">7. Manner of the Zidonians - Who living in a very strong
place, and abounding in wealth, and perceiving that the Israelites never
attempted anything against them, were grown secure and careless. Put to
shame - Or, that might rebuke or punish any thing, that is, any crime.
Putting to shame seems to be used for inflicting civil punishment,
because shame is generally the effect of it. Zidonians - Who otherwise
could have succored them, and would have been ready to do it. No
business-No league or confederacy, nor much converse with other cities,
it being in a pleasant and plentiful soil, between the two rivulets of
Jor and Daniel, not needing supplies from others, and therefore minding
only their own ease and pleasure.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p7">10. Given - This they gather partly from God's promise
which they supposed they had from the Levite's mouth; and partly from
his providence, which had so disposed them, that they would be an easy
prey.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p8">12. Mahaneh-dan - That is, the camp of Daniel.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p9">13. To the house - That is, to the town in which his
house was, for they were not yet entered into it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p10">14. Answered - That is, spake, the word answering being
often used in scripture of the first speaker. These houses - That is, in
one of these houses. What to do - Whether it be not expedient to take
them for your farther use.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p11">17. Thither - Into the house, and that part of it, where
those things were. The gate - Whither they had drawn him forth, that
they might without noise or hindrance take them away.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p12">18. These - The five men.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p13">19. Lay thy hand - That is, be silent. A family - Namely,
a tribe, that is, a family.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p14">20. Was glad - Being wholly governed by his own interest.
The midst - Both for the greater security of such precious things, and
that Micah might not be able to come at him, to injure or upbraid him;
and, it may be, because that was the place where the ark used to be
carried.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p15">21. Before them - For their greater security, if Micah
should pursue them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p16">24. I made - So far was he besotted with superstition and
idolatry, that he esteemed those gods, which were man's work. But he
could not be so stupid, as to think these were indeed the great Jehovah
that made heaven and earth; but only a lower sort of gods, by whom, as
mediators, he offered up his worship to the true God, as divers of the
Heathen did. What have I - I value nothing I have in comparison of what
you have taken away. Which zeal for idolatrous trash may shame
multitudes that call themselves Christians, and yet value their worldly
conveniences more than all the concerns of their own salvation. Is Micah
thus fond of his false gods? And how ought we to be affected toward the
true God? Let us reckon our communion with God our greatest gain; and
the loss of God the sorest loss. Wo unto us, if He depart! For what have
we more.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p17">25. Thy voice - Thy complaints and reproaches. Angry
fellows - The soldiers, who are in themselves sharp and fierce, and will
soon be enflamed by thy provoking words. Thy Life - Which, not
withstanding all thy pretenses, thou dost value more than thy
images.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p18">27. Burnt - Not wholly, but in great measure, to make
their conquest more easy.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p19">28. And they built a city - That is, rebuilt it.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p20">29. Of Daniel - That it might be manifest, that they
belonged to the tribe of Daniel, though they were seated at a great
distance from them, in the most northerly part of the land; whereas the
lot of their tribe was in the southern part of Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p21">30. Image - Having succeeded in their expedition
according to the prediction which, as they supposed, they had from this
image, they had a great veneration for it. The captivity - When the
whole land of the ten tribes, whereof Daniel was one, was conquered, and
the people carried captive by the Assyrian, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xvii. 6, 23" id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p21.1" parsed="|2Kgs|17|6|0|0;|2Kgs|17|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.17.6 Bible:2Kgs.17.23">2 Kings xvii, 6,
23</scripRef>, which is called by way of eminency, the captivity. It is
not said, that the graven image was there so long, for that is
restrained to a shorter date, even to the continuance of the ark in
Shiloh, ver. 31, which was removed thence, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. iv. 3-5" id="ii.viii.xix.ii-p21.2" parsed="|1Sam|4|3|4|5" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.4.3-1Sam.4.5">1 Sam. iv, 3-5</scripRef>. But only that Jonathan's posterity, (so his name is at last
mentioned) were priests to this tribe or family of Daniel, which they
might be under all the changes, even 'till the Assyrian captivity,
sometimes more openly, sometimes more secretly, sometimes in one way of
idolatry, and sometimes in another.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="57.39%" prev="ii.viii.xix.ii" next="ii.viii.xx.i" id="ii.viii.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XIX" id="ii.viii.xx-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="57.39%" prev="ii.viii.xx" next="ii.viii.xx.ii" id="ii.viii.xx.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xx.i-p1">The adultery of the Levite's concubine, ver. 1, 2. The
reconciliation to her, and entertainment at her father's, ver. 3-9. His
journey homeward as far as Gibeah, ver. 10-15. An Ephraimite takes him
in, ver. 16-21. The men of Gibeah assault the house, ver. 22-24. They
force his concubine to death, ver. 25- 28. He sends notice of it to all
the tribes of Israel, ver. 29, 30</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="57.39%" prev="ii.viii.xx.i" next="ii.viii.xxi" id="ii.viii.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p1">1. A. concubine - Hebrew. a wife, a concubine, that is,
such a concubine as was also his wife: called a concubine, only because
she was not endowed. Perhaps he had nothing to endow her with, being
himself only a sojourner.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p2">2. Against him - That is, against her faith given to him.
Went away - Either for fear of punishment; or, because her heart was
alienated from him; wherein not only she sinned, but her father by
connivance at her sin, and neglect of just endeavours for her
reconciliation to her husband.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p3">3. Friendly - To offer her pardon and reconciliation.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p4">12. A stranger - That is, of a strange nation: which the
Canaanites possess; for though the city Jerusalem had been taken by
Caleb, chap. i, 8, yet the strong fort of Zion was still in their hands,
whence it is likely they did much molest, and afterwards by God's
permission, drive out the Israelites who dwelt there.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p5">15. To lodge - Though they were soft and effeminate in
other respects, yet they were hard-hearted to strangers, and at that
time there were no public-houses in that country.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p6">16. Ephraim - Whence also the Levite was, which enclined
him to shew the more kindness to his country-man. Benjamites - This was
indeed one of the cities belonging to the priests; but the cities which
were given to the priests, and whereof they were owners, were not
inhabited by the priests or Levites only, especially at this time when
they were but few in number, but by many other persons of different
professions.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p7">18. House of the Lord - Which was in Shiloh. Thither he
went, either because he lived there, for that was in the tribe of
Ephraim; or, rather, because he would there offer prayers and praises,
and sacrifices to God, for his mercy in reconciling him and his
wife.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p8">20. Let all, &amp;c. - It matters not whether thou
wantest nothing or everything, I will take care to supply all thy
wants.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p9">21. Washed - As they used to do to travelers in those hot
countries.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p10">22. Merry - That is, refreshing themselves with the
provisions set before them. Sons of belial - Children of the devil,
wicked and licentious men.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p11">23. Into my house - And therefore I am obliged to protect
him by the laws of hospitality.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p12">26. Fell down - Namely, dead; killed partly with grief of
heart, and partly with excessive abuse. Thus the sin she formerly chose,
ver. 2, is now her destruction; and though her husband pardoned her, God
would punish her, at least as to this life.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p13">29. Sent - By several messengers, with a relation of the
fact.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xx.ii-p14">30. Speak - Let us meet together, and seriously consider,
and every one freely speak what is to be done in this case.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="57.44%" prev="ii.viii.xx.ii" next="ii.viii.xxi.i" id="ii.viii.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XX" id="ii.viii.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="57.44%" prev="ii.viii.xxi" next="ii.viii.xxi.ii" id="ii.viii.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.i-p1">The Levite's case heard in a general convention of the
tribes, ver. 1-7. They resolve to avenge his quarrel, ver. 8-11. The
Benjamites assemble in defense of the criminals, ver. 12-17. The defeat
of Israel in the two first battles, ver. 18-25. They humble themselves
before God, ver. 26-28. The total rout of the Benjamites, ver.
29-48.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="57.45%" prev="ii.viii.xxi.i" next="ii.viii.xxii" id="ii.viii.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p1">1. All - That is, a great number, and especially the
rulers of all the tribes, except Benjamin, ver. 3, 12. One man - That
is, with one consent. Daniel, &amp;c. - Daniel was the northern border
of the land, near Lebanon; and Beersheba the southern border. Gilead -
Beyond Jordan, where Reuben, Gad, and half Manasseh were. To the Lord -
As to the Lord's tribunal: for God was not only present in the place
where the ark and tabernacle was, but also in the assemblies of the
gods, or Judges, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxxii. 1" id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Ps|82|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.82.1">Psalm lxxxii, 1</scripRef>, and in all places where God's name is recorded, <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 24" id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Exod|20|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.24">Exod. xx, 24</scripRef>, and where two or three are met together in his name. Mizpeh
- A place on the borders of Judah and Benjamin. This they chose, as a
place they used to meet in upon solemn occasions, for its convenient
situation for all the tribes within and without Jordan; and the being
near the place where the fact was done, that it might be more throughly
examined; and not far from Shiloh, where the tabernacle was, whither
they might go or send.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p2">2. Four hundred thousand - The number is here set down,
to shew their zeal and forwardness in punishing such a villainy; the
strange blindness of the Benjamites that durst oppose so great and
united a Body; and that the success of battles depends not upon great
numbers, seeing this great host was twice defeated by the
Benjamites.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p3">3. Heard - Like persons unconcerned and resolved, they
neither went nor sent thither: partly for their own pride, and
stubbornness; partly because as they were loth to give up any of their
brethren to justice, so they presumed the other tribes would never
proceed to war against them; and partly, from a Divine infatuation
hardening that wicked tribe to their own destruction. Tell us - They
speak to the Levite, and his servant, and his host, who doubtless were
present upon this occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p4">5. Slain me - Except I would either submit to their
unnatural lust, which I was resolved to withstand even unto death: or
deliver up my concubine to them, which I was forced to do.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p5">6. Folly - That is, a lewd folly; most ignominious and
impudent wickedness.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p6">7. Ye are - The sons of that holy man, who for one filthy
action left an eternal brand upon one of his own sons: a people in
covenant with the holy God, whose honour you are obliged to vindicate,
and who hath expressly commanded you to punish all such notorious
enormities.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p7">8. His tent - That is, his habitation, until we have
revenged this injury.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p8">10. According, &amp;c. - That we may punish them as such
a wickedness deserves. In Israel - This is added as an aggravation, that
they should do that in Israel, or among God's peculiar people, which was
esteemed abominable even among the Heathen.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p9">12. All the tribe - They take a wise and a just course,
in sending to all the parts of the tribe, to separate the innocent from
the guilty, and to give them a fair opportunity of preventing their
ruin, by doing what their duty, honour, and interest obliged them to; by
delivering up those vile malefactors, whom they could not keep without
bringing the curse of God upon themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p10">13. Evil - Both the guilt and the punishment, wherein all
Israel will be involved, if they do not punish it. Would not hearken -
From the pride of their hearts, which made them scorn to submit to their
brethren; from a conceit of their own valour; and from God's just
judgment.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p11">15. Were numbered - "How does this agree with the
following numbers? For all that were slain of Benjamin were twenty-five
thousand and one hundred men, ver. 35, and there were only six hundred
that survived, ver. 47, which make only twenty-five thousand and seven
hundred." The other thousand men were either left in some of their
cities, where they were slain, ver. 48, or were cut off in the two first
battles, wherein it is unreasonable to think they had an unbloody
victory: and as for these twenty-five thousand and one hundred men, they
were all slain in the third battle.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p12">16. Not miss - An hyperbolical expression, signifying,
that they could do this with great exactness. And this was very
considerable and one ground of the Benjamites confidence.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p13">17. Men of Israel - Such as were here present, for it is
probable they had a far greater number of men, being six hundred
thousand before their entrance into Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p14">18. Children of Israel - Some sent in the name of all.
House of God - To Shiloh, which was not far from Mizpeh. Which - This
was asked to prevent emulations and contentions: but they do not ask
whether they should go against them, or no, for that they knew they
ought to do by the will of God already revealed: nor yet do they seek to
God for his help by prayer, and fasting, and sacrifice, as in all reason
they ought to have done; but were confident of success, because of their
great numbers, and righteous cause.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p15">21. Destroyed, &amp;c. - Why would God suffer them to
have so great a loss in so good a cause? Because they had many and great
sins reigning among themselves, and they should not have come to so
great a work of God, with polluted hands, but should have pulled the
beam out of their own eye, before they attempted to take that out of
their brother Benjamin's eye: which because they did not, God doth it
for them, bringing them through the fire, that they might he purged from
their dross; it being probable that the great God who governs every
stroke in battle, did so order things, that their worst members should
be cut off, which was a great blessing to the whole common - wealth. And
God would hereby shew, that the race is not to the swift, nor the battle
to the strong. We must never lay that weight on an arm of flesh, which
only the Rock of Ages will bear.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p16">22. Encouraged - Hebrew. strengthened themselves,
supporting themselves with the consciousness of the justice of their
cause, and putting themselves in better order for defending themselves,
and annoying their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p17">23. Wept - Not so much for their sins, as for their
defeat and loss. My brother-They impute their ill success, not to their
own sins, but to their taking up arms against their brethren. But still
they persist in their former neglect of seeking God's assistance in the
way which he had appointed, as they themselves acknowledged presently,
by doing those very things which now they neglected.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p18">26. Fasted - Sensible of their not being truly humbled
for their sins, which now they discover to be the cause of their ill
success. Burnt, &amp;c. - To make atonement to God for their own sins.
Peace- offerings - To bless God for sparing so many of them, whereas he
might justly have cut off all of them when their brethren were slain: to
implore his assistance, yea and to give thanks for the victory, which
now they were confident he would give them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p19">28. Phinehas - This is added to give us light about the
time of this history, and to shew it was not done in the order in which
it is here placed, after Samson's death, but long before. Stood - That
is ministered as high-priest. The Lord said - When they sought God after
the due order, and truly humbled themselves for their sins, he gives
them a satisfactory answer.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p20">29. Liers in wait - Though they were assured of the
success, by a particular promise, yet they do not neglect the use of
means; as well knowing that the certainty of God's promises doth not
excuse, but rather require man's diligent use of all fit means for the
accomplishment of them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p21">30. The children of Israel - That is, a considerable part
of them, who were ordered to give the first onset, and then to
counterfeit flight, to draw the Benjamites forth from their strong-hold.
See ver. 32.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p22">34. Chosen men - Selected out of the main body, which was
at Baal-tamar; and these were to march directly to Gibeah on the one
side, whilst the liers in wait stormed it on the other side, and whilst
the great body of the army laboured to intercept the Benjamites, who
having pursued the Israelites that pretended to flee, now endeavoured to
retreat to Gibeah.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p23">37. Drew along - Or, extended themselves; whereas before
they lay close and contracted into a narrow compass, now they spread
themselves, and marched in rank and file as armies do.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p24">44. There fell - Namely, in the field, of battle.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p25">45. Gleaned - That is, a metaphor from those who gather
grapes or corn so clearly and fully, that they leave no relicks for
those who come after them.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p26">46. Twenty and five thousand - Besides the odd hundred
expressed ver.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p27">35, but here only the great number is mentioned, the less
being omitted, as inconsiderable. Here are also a thousand more omitted,
because he speaks only of them who fell in that third day of battle.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p28">48. Turned again - Having destroyed those that came to
Gibeah, and into the field, now they follow them home to their several
habitations. Men - Comprehensively taken, so as to include women and
children. If this seem harsh and bloody, either it may be ascribed to
military fury; or perhaps it may be partly justified, from that command
of God in a parallel case, <scripRef passage="Deut. xiii. 15" id="ii.viii.xxi.ii-p28.1" parsed="|Deut|13|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.13.15">Deut. xiii, 15</scripRef>, and from that solemn oath by which they had devoted to
death all that came not up to Mizpeh, chap. xxi, 5, which none of the
Benjamites did.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="57.61%" prev="ii.viii.xxi.ii" next="ii.viii.xxii.i" id="ii.viii.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Judges XXI" id="ii.viii.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|Judg|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.viii.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="57.61%" prev="ii.viii.xxii" next="ii.viii.xxii.ii" id="ii.viii.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.i-p1">The lamentation of Israel over Benjamin, ver. 1-7. They
procure wives for the remaining Benjamites of the virgins of
Jabesh-Gilead, ver. 8-15. And of the daughters of Shiloh, ver. 16-
25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="57.61%" prev="ii.viii.xxii.i" next="ii.ix" id="ii.viii.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p1">1. Had sworn - In the beginning of this war, after the
whole tribe had espoused the quarrel of the men of Gibeah. Saying - They
do not here swear the utter extirpation of the tribe, which fell out
beyond their expectation, but only not to give their daughters to those
men who should survive; justly esteeming them for their villainy, to be
as bad as Heathens, with whom they were forbidden to marry.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p2">4. An altar - Not for a monument of the victory, but for
sacrifices, as the next words shew. There might be in that place more
altars than one, when the multitude of sacrifices be required, which was
the case, <scripRef passage="1 Kings viii. 64" id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|1Kgs|8|64|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.8.64">1 Kings viii, 64</scripRef>, and probably at this time, when all the tribes being met,
they had many sacrifices to offer, some in common for all, and some
peculiar to every tribe.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p3">5. Great oath - That is a solemn oath joined with some
terrible execration against the offenders herein. Put to death - Because
by refusing to execute the vengeance due to such malefactors, they were
justly presumed guilty of the crime, and therefore liable to the same
punishment, as was the case of that city that would not deliver up an
Idolater dwelling among them, to justice.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p4">6. Repented - Not for the war, which was just and
necessary, but for their immoderate severity in the execution of it.
That is no good divinity which swallows up humanity. Even necessary
justice is to be done with compassion.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p5">15. The Lord, &amp;c. - The Benjamites were the only
authors of the sin, but God was the chief author of the punishment, and
the Israelites were but his executioners.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p6">17. An inheritance - The inheritance promised by Jacob
and Moses, and given by Joshua to the tribe of Benjamin, doth all of it
belong to those few who remain of that tribe, and cannot be possessed by
any other tribe; and therefore we are obliged to procure wives for them
all, that they may make up this breach, and be capable of possessing and
managing all their land: that this tribe, and their inheritance may not
be confounded with, or swallowed up by any of the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p7">19. A feast - Probably it was the feast of tabernacles,
which they celebrated with more than ordinary joy. And that feast was
the only season, at which the Jewish virgins were allowed to dance. But
even this was not mixed dancing. No men danced with these daughters of
Shiloh. Nor did the married women so forget their gravity, as to join
with them. However their dancing thus in public, made them an easy prey:
whence Bishop Hall observes, "The ambushes of evil spirits carry away
many souls from dancing to a fearful desolation."</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p8">21. Daughters of Shiloh - By whom we may understand not
those only who were born or settled inhabitants there, but all those who
were come thither upon this occasion, and for a time sojourned there:
for although only the males were obliged to go up to the three solemn
feasts; yet the women had liberty to go, and those who were most devout
did usually go. Vineyards - Which were near to the green where they
danced. Catch - Take them away by force, which they might the better do,
because the women danced by themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p9">23. And took, &amp;c. - That is, each man his wife. By
which we may see, they had no very favourable opinion of polygamy,
because they did not allow it in this case, when it might seem most
necessary for the reparation of a lost tribe. Repaired - By degrees,
increasing their buildings as their number increased.</p>

<p id="ii.viii.xxii.ii-p10">25. Right in his own eyes - What wonder was it then, if
all wickedness overflowed the land? Blessed be God for magistracy!</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE BOOK OF RUTH" progress="57.67%" prev="ii.viii.xxii.ii" next="ii.ix.i" id="ii.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ruth" id="ii.ix-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.ix-p0.2">NOTES ON THE BOOK OF RUTH</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Ruth" progress="57.67%" prev="ii.ix" next="ii.ix.ii" id="ii.ix.i">

<p id="ii.ix.i-p1">This short history fitly follows the book of Judges, the
events related therein happening in the time of the Judges. It was
probably wrote by Samuel. The design of it is,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ix.i-p2">1. To lead us to Providence, acknowledging
God in all our ways;</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.ix.i-p3">2. To lead to Christ, who descended from
Ruth, and part of whose genealogy concludes the book</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="57.68%" prev="ii.ix.i" next="ii.ix.ii.i" id="ii.ix.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ruth I" id="ii.ix.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Ruth|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ruth.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ix.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="57.68%" prev="ii.ix.ii" next="ii.ix.ii.ii" id="ii.ix.ii.i">

<p id="ii.ix.ii.i-p1">Naomi removes to Moab, ver. 1, 2. Her husband and sons
die, ver. 3-5. Designing to return to Bethlehem, she addresses her
daughters-in-law, ver. 6-13. Orpah stays, but Ruth returns with her,
ver. 14-18. They came to Bethlehem, ver. 19-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="57.68%" prev="ii.ix.ii.i" next="ii.ix.iii" id="ii.ix.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p1">1. In the land - Of Canaan. It must be early: for Boaz
was born of Rahab. So Christ descended from two Gentile mothers.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p2">2. Ephrathites - Bethlehem was otherwise called Ephratha.
Naomi signifies my amiable or pleasant one: Mahlon and Chilon signify
sickness and consumption. Probably they were sickly children, and not
likely to be long-lived. Such are the products of our pleasant things,
weak and infirm, fading and dying.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p3">4. Took wives - Either these were Proselytes when they
married them, or they sinned in marrying them, and therefore were
punished with short life, and want of issue.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p4">5. Was left of her two sons, and her husband - Loss of
children and widowhood are both come upon her. By whom shall she be
comforted? It is God alone that is able to comfort those who are thus
cast down.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p5">6. Bread - That is, food; so she staid no longer there
than necessity forced her.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p6">8. Mother's house - Because daughters used to converse
more frequently with their mothers, and to dwell in the same apartments
with them, which then were distinct from those parts of the house where
the men dwelt. The dead - With my sons, your husbands, while they
lived.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p7">11. Your husbands - According to the ancient custom, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxviii. 8" id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Gen|38|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.38.8">Gen. xxxviii, 8</scripRef>, and the express law of God, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 5" id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Deut|25|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.5">Deut. xxv, 5</scripRef>, which doubtless she had acquainted them with before, among
other branches of the Jewish religion.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p8">13. It grieveth me - That you are left without the
comfort of husbands or children; that I must part with such affectionate
daughters; and that my circumstances are such, that I cannot invite you
to go alone with me. For her condition was so mean at this time, that
Ruth, when she came to her mother's city, was forced to glean for a
living. It is with me, that God has a controversy. This language becomes
us, when we are under affliction; tho' many others share in the trouble,
yet we are to hear the voice of the rod, as if it spake only to us. But
did not she wish to bring them to the worship of the God of Israel?
Undoubtedly she did. But she would have them first consider upon what
terms, lest having set their hand to the plow, they should look
back.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p9">14. Kissed - Departed from her with a kiss. Bade her
farewell forever. She loved Naomi, but she did not love her so well, as
to quit her country for her sake. Thus many have a value for Christ, and
yet come short of salvation by him, because they cannot find in their
hearts, to forsake other things for him. They love him, and yet leave
him, because they do not love him enough, but love other things
better.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p10">15. To her gods - Those that forsake the communion of
saints, will certainly break off their communion with God. This she
saith, to try Ruth's sincerity and constancy, and that she might
intimate to her, that if she went with her, she must embrace the true
religion.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p11">17. There will I be buried - Not desiring to have so much
as her dead body carried back into the land of Moab: but Naomi and she
having joined souls, she desires they may mingle dust, in hopes of
rising together, and remaining together forver. 18. Left speaking unto
her - See the power of resolution! Those who are half- resolved, are
like a door a-jar, which invites a thief. But resolution shuts and bolts
he door, and then the devil flees from us.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p12">19. Is this - Is this she that formerly lived in so much
plenty and honour? How marvelously is her condition changed?</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p13">20. Naomi - Which signifies pleasant, and chearful. Mara
- Which signifies bitter or sorrowful.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.ii.ii-p14">21. Full - With my husband and sons, and a plentiful
estate for our support. Testified - That is, hath born witness, as it
were, in judgment, and given sentence against me.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="57.75%" prev="ii.ix.ii.ii" next="ii.ix.iii.i" id="ii.ix.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ruth II" id="ii.ix.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Ruth|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ruth.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ix.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="57.75%" prev="ii.ix.iii" next="ii.ix.iii.ii" id="ii.ix.iii.i">

<p id="ii.ix.iii.i-p1">Providence directs Ruth to glean in Boaz's field, ver.
1-3. The favour which Boaz shewed her, ver. 4-16. Her return to Naomi,
ver. 17-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="57.75%" prev="ii.ix.iii.i" next="ii.ix.iv" id="ii.ix.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p1">2. Glean - Which was permitted to the poor, and the
stranger, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxiv. 19" id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Deut|24|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.24.19">Deut. xxiv, 19</scripRef>, nor was she ashamed to confess her poverty, nor would she
eat the bread of idleness. In whose sight - For though it was their duty
to permit this, yet she thought it might perhaps be denied her; at
least, that it became her modestly and humbly to acknowledge their
kindness herein.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p2">3. Her hap - It was a chance in reference to second
causes, but ordered by God's providence. God wisely orders small events,
even those that seem altogether contingent. Many a great affair is
brought about by a little turn, fortuitous as to men, but designed by
God.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p3">4. Said,&amp;c. - They expressed their piety, even in
their civil conversation, and worldly transactions; which now so many
are ashamed of.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p4">7. I pray - She did not boldly intrude herself, but
modestly ask leave of us. 'Till now - She is not retired through
idleness, for she hath been diligent and constant in her labours. The
house - In the little house or tent, which was set up in the fields at
these times, and was necessary in those hot countries, where the
labourers might retire for a little repose or repast. Being weary with
her continued labours, she comes hither to take a little rest.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p5">8. Maidens - Not by the young men, to avoid both occasion
of sin, and matter of scandal. Herein he shews his piety and
prudence.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p6">9. Touch - So as to offer any incivility or injury to
thee.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p7">10. Fell - This was the humblest posture of reverence,
either civil when performed to men, or religious, when to God. Take
knowledge - That is, shew any respect and kindness to me.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p8">12. Wings - That is, protection and care. An allusion
either to hens, which protect and cherish their young ones under their
wings; or to the wings of the Cherubim, between which God dwelt.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p9">13. Tho' I be not - I humbly implore the continuance of
thy good opinion of me, though I do not deserve it, being a person more
mean, necessitous, and, obscure, a stranger, and one born of heathen
parents, and not of the holy and honourable people of Israel, as they
are.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p10">14. She sat - Not with or among them, but at some little
distance from them, as one inferior to them. It is no disparagement to
the finest hand, to be reached forth to the needy.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p11">17. An Ephah - About a bushel.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p12">18. Reserved - At dinner, after she had eaten and was
sufficed, or satisfied.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p13">19. Where hast thou gleaned today? - It is a good
question to ask ourselves in the evening, "Where have I gleaned today?"
What improvements have I made in grace or knowledge? What have I learned
or done, which will turn to account?</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p14">20. To the dead - That is, which he formerly shewed to
those who are now dead, my husband and his sons whilst they were living,
and now continues to us.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p15">21. Harvest - Both barley-harvest, and wheat-harvest. She
tells what kindness Boaz had shewed her; but not, how he had commended
her. Humility teaches not only not to praise ourselves, but not to be
forward in repeating the praise which others have given us.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iii.ii-p16">22. Other field - Whereby thou wilt both expose thyself
to many inconveniences, which thou mayst expect from strangers; and
incur his displeasure, as if thou didst despise his kindness.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="57.81%" prev="ii.ix.iii.ii" next="ii.ix.iv.i" id="ii.ix.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ruth III" id="ii.ix.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Ruth|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ruth.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ix.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="57.81%" prev="ii.ix.iv" next="ii.ix.iv.ii" id="ii.ix.iv.i">

<p id="ii.ix.iv.i-p1">The directions Naomi gives to Ruth, ver. 1-5. Her
punctual observance of them, ver. 6, 7. The honourable treatment which
Boaz gave her, ver. 8-15. Her return to Naomi, ver. 16-18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="57.81%" prev="ii.ix.iv.i" next="ii.ix.v" id="ii.ix.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p1">1. Rest - A life of rest, and comfort, and safety, under
the care of a good husband.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p2">2. Threshing-floor - Which was in a place covered at the
top, but open elsewhere, whither Ruth might easily come. And this work
of winnowing corn was usually ended with a feast.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p3">3. Raiment - Thy best raiment. Known - In so familiar a
way, as thou mayest do hereafter.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p4">4. Uncover his feet - Remove the clothes that were upon
his feet; thereby to awaken him. Will tell thee - What course thou shalt
take to obtain that marriage which belongs unto thee.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p5">8. At midnight - He did not discover her sooner.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p6">9. Spread thy Skirt - That is, take me to be thy wife,
and perform the duty of an husband to me.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p7">10. Shewed kindness - Both to thy deceased husband, the
continuance of whose name and memory thou seekest; and to thy
mother-in-law, whose commands thou hast punctually obeyed. Followedst
not - To seek thy marriage here, or in thy own country, as thou wouldst
have done if thou hadst not preferred obedience to God's command, before
pleasing thyself.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p8">13. Perform, &amp;c. - Take thee to wife, to raise up
seed to his brother. Bishop Hall sums up the matter thus. "Boaz, instead
of touching her as a wanton, blesseth her as a father, encourages her as
a friend, promises her as a kinsman, rewards her as a patron, and sends
her away laden with hopes and gifts, no less chast, but more happy than
she came. O admirable temperance, worthy the progenitor of him, in whose
lips and heart there was no guile!"</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p9">14. Let it not, &amp;c. - He takes care to preserve not
only his conscience towards God, but his reputation, and hers also,
among men.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p10">15. Veil - Or, the apron.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.iv.ii-p11">16. Who art thou? - This is not a question of doubting,
but of wonder, as if she had said, Art thou in very deed my daughter? I
can hardly believe it. How camest thou hither in this manner, and thus
early?</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="57.84%" prev="ii.ix.iv.ii" next="ii.ix.v.i" id="ii.ix.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ruth IV" id="ii.ix.v-p0.1" parsed="|Ruth|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ruth.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.ix.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="57.84%" prev="ii.ix.v" next="ii.ix.v.ii" id="ii.ix.v.i">

<p id="ii.ix.v.i-p1">The next kinsman refuses to marry Ruth, ver. 1-8. Boaz
marries her, ver. 9-12. Their issue, ver. 13-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="57.84%" prev="ii.ix.v.i" next="ii.x" id="ii.ix.v.ii">

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p1">2. Ten men - To be witnesses: for though two or three
witnesses were sufficient, yet in weightier matters they used more. And
ten was the usual number among the Jews, in causes of matrimony and
divorce, and translation of inheritances; who were both Judges of the
causes, and witnesses of the fact.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p2">3. Naomi - Both Naomi and Ruth had an interest in this
land during their lives, but he mentions only Naomi, because all was
done by her direction; lest the mention of Ruth should raise a suspicion
of the necessity of his marrying Ruth, before he had given his answer to
the first proposition.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p3">5. Buy it - According to the law, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 5" id="ii.ix.v.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Deut|25|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.5">Deut. xxv, 5</scripRef>. To raise,&amp;c. - To revive his name, which was buried
with his body, by raising up a seed to him, to be called by his
name.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p4">6. Mar - Either because having no children of his own, he
might have one, and but one son by Ruth, who, though he should carry
away his inheritance, yet would not bear his name, but the name of
Ruth's husband; and so by preserving another man's name, he should lose
his own. Or, because as his inheritance would be but very little
increased by this marriage, so it might be much diminished by being
divided amongst his many children, which he possibly had already, and
might probably have more by Ruth. My right - Which I freely resign to
thee.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p5">7. All things - That is, in all alienation of lands. So
that it is no wonder if this ceremony differ a little from that, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 9" id="ii.ix.v.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Deut|25|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.9">Deut. xxv, 9</scripRef>, because that concerned only one case, but this is more
general. Besides, he pleads not the command of God, but only ancient
custom, for this practice. Gave it - He who relinquished his right to
another, plucked off his own shoe and gave it to him. This was
symbolical, and a significant and convenient ceremony, as if he said,
take this shoe wherewith I used to go and tread upon my land, and in
that shoe do thou enter upon it, and take possession of it. This was a
testimony - This was admitted for sufficient evidence in all such
cases.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p6">10. From the gate - That is, from among the inhabitants
dwelling within the gate of this city, which was Bethlehem-judah.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p7">11. Rachel and Leah - Amiable and fruitful. These two are
singled out, because they were of a foreign original, and yet ingrafted
into God's people, as Ruth was; and because of that fertility which God
vouchsafed unto them above their predecessors, Sarah and Rebecca. Rachel
is placed before Leah, because she was his most lawful, and best-beloved
wife. Did build - That is, increase the posterity. Ephratah and
Bethlehem - Two names of one and the same place.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p8">12. Pharez - As honourable and numerous as his family
was; whom, though be also was born of a stranger, God so blessed, that
his family was one of the five families to which all the tribe of Judah
belonged, and the progenitor of the inhabitants of this city.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p9">13. Took Ruth - Which he might do, though she was a
Moabite, because the prohibition against marrying such, is to be
restrained to those who continue Heathens; whereas Ruth was a sincere
proselyte and convert to the God of Israel. Thus he that forsakes all
for Christ, shall find more than all with him.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p10">14. Which hath not, &amp;c. - The words may be rendered,
Which hath not made, or suffered thy kinsman to fail thee; that is, to
refuse the performances of his duty to thee and thine, as the other
kinsman did. Famous - Hebrew. and his name shall be famous in Israel,
for this noble and worthy action.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p11">15. Thy life - That is, of the comfort of thy life. Born
him - Or, hath born to him; that is, to thy kinsman a son. Better than
seven sons - See how God sometimes makes up the want of those relations
from whom we expected most comfort, in those from whom we expected
least! The bonds of love prove stronger than those of nature.</p>

<p id="ii.ix.v.ii-p12">17. A name - That is, they gave her advice about his
name; for otherwise they had no power or right to do so. Obed - A
servant, to thee, to nourish, and comfort, and assist thee; which duty
children owe to their progenitors.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE FIRST BOOK OF SAMUEL" progress="57.91%" prev="ii.ix.v.ii" next="ii.x.i" id="ii.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1Sam" id="ii.x-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.x-p0.2">NOTES ON THE FIRST BOOK OF SAMUEL</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to First Samuel" progress="57.92%" prev="ii.x" next="ii.x.ii" id="ii.x.i">

<p id="ii.x.i-p1">This book and the following bear the name of Samuel, (tho'
he wrote only part of the former, and some other of the prophets,
perhaps Nathan, the rest) because they contain first a large account of
Samuel, and then the history of the reigns of Saul and David, who were
both anointed by him.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="57.92%" prev="ii.x.i" next="ii.x.ii.i" id="ii.x.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. I" id="ii.x.ii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="57.92%" prev="ii.x.ii" next="ii.x.ii.ii" id="ii.x.ii.i">

<p id="ii.x.ii.i-p1">The affliction of Hannah, ver. 1-8. Her prayer to God,
with Eli's blessing, ver. 9-18. The birth and nursing of Samuel, ver.
19-23. The presenting of him to God, ver. 24-28.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="57.92%" prev="ii.x.ii.i" next="ii.x.iii" id="ii.x.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p1">1. Ramathaim-zophim - Called Ramah, ver. 19. Eparathite -
That is, one of Bethlehem-judah, by his birth and habitation, though by
his original a Levite.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p2">2. Two wives - As many had in those ages, tho' it was a
transgression of the original institution of marriage. And it is
probable that he took his second wife, namely, Peninnah, because Hannah
was barren.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p3">3. Yearly - At the three solemn feasts, when he, together
with all other males were obliged to go to worship God in the place
appointed; and at other times, when he as a Levite, was to go thither in
his course. To sacrifice - Not in his own person, which the Levites
could not do, but by the priests. Were there - Or, were the priests of
the Lord there, under their father Eli, who is generally conceived to
have been the high-priest, but being very old and infirm, his sons
ministered in his stead. This is the first time in scripture, that God
is called the Lord of hosts or Armies. Probably Samuel was the first who
used this title of God, for the comfort of Israel, at the time when
their armies were few and feeble, and those of their enemies many and
mighty.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p4">4. Portions - Out of the sacrifice of his
peace-offerings, the greatest part whereof fell to the offerer, and was
eaten by him, and his friends or guests, before the Lord. And out of
this he gave them all portions, as the master of the feast used to do to
the guests.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p5">5. Shut up her womb - Yet Elkanah did not withdraw his
love from her. To abate out just love to any relation, for the sake of
any infirmity which they cannot help, is to add affliction to the
afflicted.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p6">6. Her adversary - Peninnah: so her envy or jealousy made
her though so nearly related.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p7">7. When she went-This circumstance is noted as the
occasion of the contention, because at such times they were forced to
more society with one another, by the way, and in their lodgings;
whereas at home they had distinct apartments, where they might be
asunder; and then her husband's extraordinary love and kindness was
shewed to Hannah, whereby Peninnah was the more exasperated; then also
Hannah prayed earnestly for a child, which hitherto she had done in
vain; and this possibly she reproached her with. Did not eat - Being
overwhelmed with grief, and therefore unfit to eat of the sacred food.
Which they were not to eat in their mourning.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p8">8. Ten sons - Oughtest thou not to value my hearty love
to thee, more than the having of as many sons as Penninah hath? She
would willingly change conditions with thee.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p9">9. A seat - Or, throne; for it is manifest it was raised
higher than ordinary, chap. iv, 18. Here he might sit, either as the
judge; or rather as high-priest, to hear and answer such as came to him
for advice, and to inspect and direct the worship of God. Temple - That
is, of the tabernacle, which is frequently so called.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p10">10. Bitterness - That is, oppressed with grief. Prayed
unto the Lord - They had newly offered their peace-offerings, to obtain
the favour of God, and in token of their communion with him, they had
feasted upon the sacrifice: and now it was proper to put up her prayer,
in virtue of the sacrifice. For the peace-offerings typified Christ's
mediation, as well as the sin-offerings: since by this not only
atonement is made for sin, but an answer to our prayers obtained.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p11">11. Give him - That is, consecrate him to God's service
in his temple. No razor - That is, he shall be a perpetual Nazarite.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p12">12. Continued - Hebrew. multiplied to pray. By which it
appears that she said much more than is here expressed. And the like you
are to judge of the prayers and sermons of other holy persons recorded
in scripture, which gives us only the sum and substance of them. This
consideration may help us much to understand some passages of the
bible.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p13">13. Drunken - Because of the multitude of her words, and
those motions of her face and body, which the vehemency of her passion,
and the fervency in prayer occasioned.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p14">16. Count not, &amp;c. - Thus when we are unjustly
censured, we should endeavour not only to clear ourselves, but to
satisfy our brethren, by giving them a just and true account of that
which they misapprehended.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p15">18. Find grace - That favourable opinion and gracious
prayer which thou hast expressed on my behalf, be pleased to continue
towards me. Sad - Her heart being cheared by the priest's comfortable
words, and especially by God's spirit setting them home upon her, and
assuring her that both his and her prayers should be heard, it quickly
appeared in her countenance.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p16">19. Remembered - Manifested his remembrance of her by the
effect.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p17">20. Samuel - That is, Asked of God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p18">21. His house - Hannah only and her child excepted. His
vow - By which it appears, though it was not expressed before, that he
heard and consented to her vow, and that he added a vow of his own, if
God answered his prayers.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p19">22. Weaned - Not only from the breast, but also from the
mother's knee and care, and from childish food; 'till the child be
something grown up, and fit to do some service in the tabernacle: for it
seems that as soon as he was brought up he worshipped God, ver. 28, and
presently after ministered to Eli, chap. ii, 11.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p20">23. His word - His matter or thing; the business
concerning the child, what thou hast vowed concerning him, that be may
grow up, and be accepted and employed by God in his Service.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p21">24. Three bullocks - One for a burnt-offering, the second
for a sin- offering, and the third for a peace offering; all these sorts
being expedient for this work and time. Flour - For the meal-offerings
belonging to the principal sacrifices, which to each bullock were three
tenth-deals, or three tenth parts of an ephah, and so nine parts of the
ephah were spent, and the tenth part was given to the priest. Wine - For
drink-offerings.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p22">25. A bullock - The three bullocks mentioned ver. 24, the
singular number being put for the plural, which is frequent.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p23">26. Soul liveth - As surely as thou livest. Which
asseveration seems necessary, because this was some years after it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ii.ii-p24">28. Lent him - But not with a purpose to require him
again. Whatever we give to God, may upon this account be said to be lent
to him, that tho' we may not recall it, yet he will certainly repay it,
to our unspeakable advantage. He worshipped - Not Eli, but young Samuel,
who is spoken of in this and the foregoing verse, and who was capable of
worshipping God in some sort, at least with external adoration.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="58.04%" prev="ii.x.ii.ii" next="ii.x.iii.i" id="ii.x.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. II" id="ii.x.iii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="58.04%" prev="ii.x.iii" next="ii.x.iii.ii" id="ii.x.iii.i">

<p id="ii.x.iii.i-p1">Hannah's song of thanksgiving, ver. 1-10. Elkanah leaves
Samuel to minister before the Lord, ver. 11. The wickedness of Eli's
sons, ver. 12-17. A farther account of Samuel and his parents, ver.
18-21. Eli's too mild reproof of his sons, ver. 22-25. Samuel's growth,
ver. 26. God's dreadful message to Eli, ver. 27- 36.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="58.04%" prev="ii.x.iii.i" next="ii.x.iv" id="ii.x.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p1">1. Prayed - That is, praised God; which is a part of
prayer. Rejoiceth - Or, leapeth for joy: for the words note not only
inward joy, but also the outward demonstrations of it. In the Lord - As
the author of my joy, that he hath heard my prayer, and accepted my son
for his service. Horn - My strength and glory (which are often signified
by an horn,) are advanced and manifested to my vindication, and the
confusion of mine enemies. Mouth enlarged - That is, opened wide to pour
forth abundant praises to God, and to give a full answer to all the
reproaches of mine adversaries. Enemies - So she manifests her prudence
and modesty, in not naming Peninnah, but only her enemies in the
general. Salvation - Because the matter of my joy is no trivial thing,
but that strange and glorious salvation or deliverance which thou hast
given me from my oppressing care and grief, and from the insolencies and
reproaches of mine enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p2">2. None holy - None so perfectly, unchangeably and
constantly holy. None beside - Not only none is so holy as thou art, but
in truth there is none holy besides thee; namely, entirely, or
independently, but only by participation from thee. Any rock - Thou only
art a sure defense and refuge to all that flee to thee.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p3">3. Talk no more - Thou Peninnah, boast no more of thy
numerous off-spring, and speak no more insolently and scornfully of me.
She speaks of her in the plural number, because she would not expose her
name to censure. Of knowledge - He knoweth thy heart, and all that
pride, and envy, and contempt of me, which thy own conscience knows; and
all thy perverse carriage towards me. Actions - That is, he trieth all
mens thoughts and actions, (for the Hebrew word signifies both) as a
just judge, to give to every one according to their works.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p4">4. Bows - The strength of which they boasted. Stumbled -
Or, were weak, or feeble, in body and spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p5">5. Hired themselves out for bread - It is the same thing
which is expressed both in divers metaphors in the foregoing, and
following verses. Ceased - That is, ceased to be hungry. Seven - That
is, many, as seven is often used. She speaks in the prophetick style,
the past time, for the future; for though she had actually born but one,
yet she had a confident persuasion that she should have more, which was
grounded either upon some particular assurance from God; or rather upon
the prayer or prediction of Eli. She - That is, Peninnah. Feeble -
Either because she was now past child-bearing: or, because divers of her
children, which were her strength and her glory, were dead, as the
Hebrew doctors relate.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p6">6. Killeth - The same person whom he first killeth, or
bringeth nigh unto death, he afterwards raiseth to life. Me, who was
almost consumed with grief, he hath revived. The name of death both in
sacred scripture, and profane writers, is often given to great
Calamities.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p7">8. From the dunghill - From the most sordid place, and
mean estate. Inherit - Not only possess it themselves, but transmit it
to their posterity. Throne - That is, a glorious throne or kingdom.
Pillars - The foundations of the earth, which God created, and upholds,
and wherewith he sustains the earth, and all its inhabitants, as a house
is supported with pillars; and therefore it is not strange if he
disposeth of persons and things therein as he pleaseth.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p8">9. Feet - That is, the steps or paths, their counsels and
actions; he will keep; that is, both uphold, that they may not fall into
ruin; and direct and preserve from wandering, and from those fatal
errors that wicked men daily run into. Silent - Shall be put to silence:
they who used to open their mouths wide against heaven, and against the
saints, shall be so confounded with the unexpected disappointment of all
their hopes, and with God's glorious appearance and operations for his
people, that they shall have their mouths quite stopped. Darkness - Both
inward, in their own minds, not knowing what to say or do; and outward,
in a stat e of deep distress. Prevail - Namely, against God, or against
his saints, as the wicked were confident they should do, because of
their great power, and wealth, and numbers.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p9">10. Exalt - Increase, or advance the strength. Of his
anointed - Of his king. This may respect Christ, the singular anointed
one of God, and the special king of his people. In this sense also, the
Lord shall judge the ends of the earth: David's victories and dominions
reached far. But God will give to the Son of David, the uttermost parts
of the earth for his possession. And he will give strength unto his
king, for the accomplishing his great undertaking, and exalt the horn,
of the power and honour of his anointed, till he hath put all his
enemies under his feet.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p10">11. Minster - In some way agreeable to his tender years,
as in singing, or playing upon instruments of musick, or lighting the
lamps. Before Eli the priest - That is, under the inspection, and by the
direction of Eli.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p11">12. Knew not - They did not honour, love, or serve
God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p12">13. Boiling - As the Lord's part of the peace-offerings
was burnt upon the altar, so the priest's and offerer's parts were to be
boiled.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p13">14. Took - Not contented with the breast and shoulder
which were allotted them by God, they took also part of the offerer's
share; besides which they snatched their part before it was heaved and
waved; contrary to <scripRef passage="Levit vii. 34" id="ii.x.iii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Lev|7|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.7.34">Levit vii, 34</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p14">15. The fat - And the other parts to be burnt with it. So
this was all additional injury; for they took such parts as they best
liked whilst it was raw.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p15">17. Abhorred - But we know the validity and efficacy of
the sacraments does not depend on the goodness of those that administer
them. It was therefore folly and sin in the people, to think the worse
of God's institutions. But it was the much greater sin of the priests,
that gave them occasion so to do.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p16">18. Ministered - That is, performed his ministration
carefully and faithfully. Before the Lord - In God's tabernacle. Ephod -
A garment used in God's service, and allowed not only to the inferior
priests and Levites but also to eminent persons of the people, and
therefore to Samuel, who, though no Levite, was a Nazarite, from his
birth.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p17">21. Grew - Not only in age and stature; but especially in
wisdom and goodness. Before the Lord - Not only before men, who might he
deceived, but in the presence and judgment of the all-seeing God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p18">22. Very old - And therefore unfit either to manage his
office himself, or to make a diligent inspection into the carriage of
his sons, which gave them opportunity for their wickedness. To Israel -
Whom they injured in their offerings, and alienated from the service of
God. The door - The place where all the people both men and women waited
when they came up to the service of God, because the altar on which
their sacrifices was offered, was by the door.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p19">23. He said, &amp;c. - Eli's sin was not only that he
reproved them too gently, but that he contented himself with a verbal
rebuke, and did not restrain them, and inflict those punishments upon
them which such high crimes deserved by God's law, and which he as judge
and high-priest ought to have done, without respect of persons.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p20">25. The judge - If only man be wronged, man can right it,
and reconcile the persons. Against the Lord - As you have done wilfully
and presumptuously. Who shall, &amp;c. - The offense is of so high a
nature, that few or none will dare to intercede for him, but will leave
him to the just judgment of God. The words may be rendered, Who shall
judge for him? Who shall interpose as umpire, between God and him? Who
shall compound that difference? None can or dare do it, and therefore he
must be left to the dreadful, but righteous judgment of God. They had
now sinned away their day of grace. They had long hardened their hearts.
And God at length gave them up to a reprobate mind, and determined to
destroy them, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxv. 16" id="ii.x.iii.ii-p20.1" parsed="|2Chr|25|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.25.16">2 Chron. xxv, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p21">27. Man of God - That is, a prophet sent from God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p22">29. Kick ye - Using them irreverently, and profanely;
both by abusing them to your own luxury, and by causing the people to
abhor them. He chargeth Eli with his sons faults. honourest thy sons -
Permitting them to dishonour and injure me, by taking my part to
themselves; chusing rather to offend me by thy connivance at their sin,
than to displease them by severe rebukes, and just punishments. Fat - To
pamper yourselves. This you did not out of necessity, but out of mere
luxury. Chiefest - Not contented with those parts which I had allotted
you, you invaded those choice parts which I reserved for myself.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p23">30. I said - Where, or when did God say this? To Eli
himself, or to his father, when the priesthood was translated from
Eleazar's to Ithamar's family. Walk - That is, minister unto me as
high-priest. Walking is often put for discharging ones office; before
me; may signify that he was the high-priest, whose sole prerogative it
was to minister before God, or before the ark, in the most holy place.
For ever - As long as the Mosaical law and worship lasts. Far from me -
To fulfil my promise, which I hereby retract.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p24">31. Arm - That is, I will take away thy strength, or all
that in which thou placest thy confidence, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.x.iii.ii-p25">1. the ark, which is called God's strength,
<scripRef passage="Psalm lxxviii. 61" id="ii.x.iii.ii-p25.1" parsed="|Ps|78|61|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.78.61">Psalm lxxviii, 61</scripRef>, and was Eli's strength, who therefore was not able to bear
the very tidings of the loss of it. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.x.iii.ii-p26">2. his priestly dignity or employment,
whence he had all his honour and substance. Or rather,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.x.iii.ii-p27">3. his children, to whom the words
following here, and in the succeeding verses, seem to confine it.
Father's house - That is, thy children's children, and all thy family
which was in great measure accomplished, chap. xxii, 16, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p28">32. Shalt see,&amp;c. - The words may be rendered; thou
shalt see, in thy own person, the affliction, or calamity of my
habitation; that is, either of the land of Israel, wherein I dwell; or
of the sanctuary, called the habitation by way of eminency, whose
greatest glory the ark was, chap. iv, 21, 22, and consequently, whose
greatest calamity the loss of the ark was; for, or instead of all that
good wherewith God would have blessed Israel, having raised up a young
prophet Samuel, and thereby given good grounds of hope that he intended
to bless Israel, if thou and thy sons had not hindered it by your sins.
So this clause of the threatning concerns Eli's person, as the following
concerns his posterity. And this best agrees with the most proper
signification of that phrase, Thou shalt see.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p29">33. Of thine - That is, of thy posterity. Shalt grieve -
Shall be so forlorn and miserable, that if thou wast alive to see it, it
would grieve thee at the heart, and thou wouldst consume thine eyes with
weeping for their calamities. Increase - That is, thy children. Flower -
About the thirtieth year of their age, when they were to be admitted to
the full administration of their office.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iii.ii-p30">35. Raise a priest - Of another line, as it necessarily
implied by the total removal of that office from Eli's line. The person
designed is Zadok, one eminent for his faithfulness to God, and to the
king, who, when Abiather, the last of Eli's line, was deposed by
Solomon, was made high-priest in his stead. Build,&amp;c. - That is,
give him a numerous posterity, and confirm that sure covenant of an
everlasting priesthood made to Phinehas, of Eleazar's line, <scripRef passage="Num. xxv. 13" id="ii.x.iii.ii-p30.1" parsed="|Num|25|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.25.13">Num. xxv, 13</scripRef>, and interrupted for a little while by Eli, of the line of
Ithamar, unto him and his children forever. Anointed - Before Jesus
Christ, who is the main scope and design, not only of the New, but of
the Old Testament, which in all its types and ceremonies represented
him; and particularly, the high-priest was an eminent type of Christ,
and represented his person, and acted in his name and stead, and did
mediately, what John Baptist did immediately, go before the face of the
Lord Christ; and when Christ came, that office and officer was to cease.
The high-priest is seldom or never said to walk or minister before the
kings of Israel or Judah, but constantly before the Lord, and
consequently, before Christ, who, as he was God blessed forever, <scripRef passage="Rom. ix. 5" id="ii.x.iii.ii-p30.2" parsed="|Rom|9|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rom.9.5">Rom. ix, 5</scripRef>, was present with, and the builder and governor of the
ancient church of Israel, and therefore the high-priest is most properly
said to walk before him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="58.26%" prev="ii.x.iii.ii" next="ii.x.iv.i" id="ii.x.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. III" id="ii.x.iv-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="58.26%" prev="ii.x.iv" next="ii.x.iv.ii" id="ii.x.iv.i">

<p id="ii.x.iv.i-p1">God's first manifestation of himself to Samuel, ver.
1-10. God's message to Eli, ver. 11-14. His faithful delivery of that
message, and Eli's submission to God, ver. 15-18. The establishment of
Samuel to be a prophet, ver. 19-21</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="58.26%" prev="ii.x.iv.i" next="ii.x.v" id="ii.x.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p1">1. Before Eli - That is, under his inspection and
direction. Word - The word of prophecy, or the Revelation of God's will
to and by the prophets. Precious - Rare or scarce, such things being
most precious in mens' esteem, whereas common things are generally
despised. Open vision - God did not impart his Mind by way of vision or
Revelation openly, or to any public person, to whom others might resort
for satisfaction, though he might privately reveal himself to some pious
persons for their particular direction. This is premised, as a reason
why Samuel understood not, when God called him once or twice.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p2">2. His place - In the court of the tabernacle.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p3">3. Went out - Before the lights of the golden candlestick
were put out in the morning.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p4">7. Did not know - He was not acquainted with God in that
extraordinary or prophetical way. And this ignorance of Samuel's served
God's design, that his simplicity might give Eli the better assurance of
the truth of God's call, and message to Samuel.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p5">10. Came and stood - Before, he spake to him at a
distance, even from the holy oracle between the cherubim: but now, to
prevent all farther mistake, the voice came near to him, as if the
person speaking had been standing near him.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p6">12. In that day - In that time which I have appointed for
this work, which was about twenty or thirty years after this threatning.
So long space of repentance God allows to this wicked generation. When I
begin, &amp;c. - Tho' this vengeance shall be delayed for a season, to
manifest my patience, and incite them to repentance; yet when once I
begin to inflict, I shall not desist 'till I have made a full end.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p7">13. Restrained them not - He contented himself with a
cold reproof, and did not punish, and effectually restrain them. They
who can, and do not restrain others from sin, make themselves partakers
of the guilt. Those in authority will have a great deal to answer for,
if the sword they bear be not a terror to evil-doers.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p8">14. Have sworn - Or, I do swear: the past tense being
commonly put for the present in the Hebrew tongue. Unto - Or, concerning
it. Purged - That is, the punishment threatened against Eli and his
family, shall not he prevented by all their sacrifices, but shall
infallibly be executed.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p9">15. Doors - Altho' the tabernacle, whilst it was to be
removed from place to place in the wilderness, had no doors, but
consisted only of curtains, and had hangings before the entrance,
instead of doors; yet when it was settled in one place, as now it was in
Shiloh, it was enclosed within some solid building, which had doors and
posts, and other parts belonging to it. Feared - The matter of the
vision or Revelation, partly from the reverence he bore to his person,
to whom he was loth to be a messenger of such sad tidings; partly, lest
if he had been hasty to utter it, Eli might think him guilty of
arrogancy or secret complacency in his calamity.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p10">17. God do so, &amp;c. - God inflict the same evils upon
thee, which I suspect he hath pronounced against me, and greater evils
too.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p11">18. It is the Lord - This severe sentence is from the
sovereign Lord of the world, who hath an absolute right to dispose of me
and all his creatures; who is in a special manner the ruler of the
people of Israel, to whom it properly belongs to punish all mine
offenses; whose chastisement I therefore accept.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p12">19. Fail, &amp;c. - That is, want its effect: God made
good all his predictions. A metaphor from precious liquors, which when
they are spilt upon the ground, are altogether useless.</p>

<p id="ii.x.iv.ii-p13">20. From Daniel, &amp;c. - Thro' the whole Land, from the
northern bound Daniel, to the southern, Beersheba; which was the whole
length of the Land.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="58.33%" prev="ii.x.iv.ii" next="ii.x.v.i" id="ii.x.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. IV" id="ii.x.v-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="58.33%" prev="ii.x.v" next="ii.x.v.ii" id="ii.x.v.i">

<p id="ii.x.v.i-p1">Israel smitten by the Philistines, ver. 1, 2. They bring
the ark into the camp, which affrights the Philistines, ver. 3-9. Israel
beaten and the ark taken, ver. 10, 11. The news brought to Shiloh and
the death of Eli, ver. 12-18. The travail and death of his
daughter-in-law, 19-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="58.33%" prev="ii.x.v.i" next="ii.x.vi" id="ii.x.v.ii">

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p1">1. The word - That is, the word of the Lord revealed to
Samuel, and by him to the people. A word of command, that all Israel
should go forth to fight with the Philistines, as the following words
explain it, that they might he first humbled and punished for their
sins, and so prepared for deliverance. Went out - To meet the
Philistines, who having by this time recruited themselves after their
loss by Samson, and perceiving an eminent prophet arising among them, by
whom they were likely to be united, and assisted, thought fit to
suppress them in the beginning of their hopes.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p2">3. Wherefore, &amp;c. - This was strange blindness, that
when there was so great a corruption in their worship and manners, they
could not see sufficient reason why God should suffer them to fall by
their enemies. The ark - That great pledge of God's presence and help,
by whose conduct our ancestors obtained success. Instead of humbling
themselves for, and purging themselves from their sins, for which God
was displeased with them, they take an easier and cheaper course, and
put their trust in their ceremonial observances, not doubting but the
very presence of the ark would give them the victory.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p3">4. Bring the ark - This they should not have done without
asking counsel of God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p4">5. Shouted - From their great joy and confidence of
success. So formal Christians triumph in external privileges and
performances: as if the ark in the camp would bring them to heaven, tho'
the world and the flesh reign in the heart.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p5">7. Heretofore - Not in our times; for the fore-mentioned
removals of the ark were before it came to Shiloh.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p6">8. Wo, &amp;c. - They secretly confess the Lord to be
greater than their gods, and yet presume to oppose him. Wilderness -
They mention the wilderness, not as if all the plagues of the Egyptians
came upon them in the wilderness, but because the last and sorest of
all, which is therefore put for all, the destruction of Pharaoh and all
his host, happened in the wilderness, namely, in the Red- sea, which
having the wilderness on both sides of it, may well be said to be in the
wilderness. Altho' it is not strange if these Heathens did mistake some
circumstance in relation of the Israelitish affairs, especially some
hundreds of years after they were done.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p7">10. Tent - To his habitation, called by the ancient name
of his tent. There fell - Before, they lost but four thousand, now in
the presence of the ark, thirty thousand, to teach them that the ark and
ordinances of God, were never designed as a refuge to impenitent
sinners, but only for the comfort of those that repent.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p8">11. The ark - Which God justly and wisely permitted, to
punish the Israelites for their profanation of it; that by taking away
the pretenses of their foolish confidence, he might more deeply humble
them, and bring them to true-repentance: and that the Philistines might
by this means he more effectually convinced of God's almighty power, and
of their own, and the impotency of their gods, and so a stop put to
their triumphs and rage against the poor Israelites. Thus as God was no
loser by this event, so the Philistines were no gainers by it; and
Israel, all things considered, received more good than hurt by it. If
Eli had done his duty, and put them from the priesthood, they might have
lived, tho' in disgrace. But now God takes the work into his own hands,
and chases them out of the world by the sword of the Philistines.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p9">13. The ark - Whereby he discovered a public and generous
spirit, and a fervent zeal for God, and for his honour, which he
preferred before all his natural affections, not regarding his own
children in comparison of the ark, tho' otherwise he was a most
indulgent father. And well they might, for beside that this was a
calamity to all Israel, it was a particular loss to Shiloh; for the ark
never returned thither. Their candlestick was removed out of its place,
and the city sunk and came to nothing.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p10">18. He fell - Being so oppressed with grief and
astonishment, that he had no strength left to support him. The gate -
The gate of the city, which was most convenient for the speedy
understanding of all occurrences. Old - Old, and therefore weak and apt
to fall; heavy, and therefore his fall more dangerous. So fell the high-
priest and judge of Israel! So fell his heavy head, when he had lived
within two of an hundred years! So fell the crown from his head, when he
had judged Israel forty years: thus did his sun set under a cloud. Thus
was the wickedness of those sons of his, whom he had indulged, his ruin.
Thus does God sometimes set marks of his displeasure on good men, that
others may hear and fear. Yet we must observe, it was the loss of the
ark that was his death, and not the slaughter of his sons. He says in
effect, Let me fall with the ark! Who can live, when the ordinances of
God are removed? Farewell all in this world, even Life itself, if the
ark be gone!</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p11">20. Fear not - Indeed the sorrows of her travail would
have been forgotten, for joy that a child was born into the world. But
what is that joy to one that feels herself dying? None but spiritual joy
will stand us in stead then. Death admits not the relish of any earthly
joy: it is then all flat and tasteless. What is it to one that is
lamenting the loss of the ark? What can give us pleasure, if we want
God's word and ordinances? Especially if we want the comfort of his
gracious presence, and the light of his countenance?</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p12">21. I-chabod - Where is the glory? The glory - That is,
the glorious type and assurance of God's presence, the ark, which is
often called God's glory, and which wast the great safeguard and
ornament of Israel, which they could glory in above all other
nations.</p>

<p id="ii.x.v.ii-p13">22. The ark - This is repeated to shew, her piety, and
that the public loss lay heavier upon her spirit, than her personal or
domestic calamity.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="58.44%" prev="ii.x.v.ii" next="ii.x.vi.i" id="ii.x.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. V" id="ii.x.vi-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="58.44%" prev="ii.x.vi" next="ii.x.vi.ii" id="ii.x.vi.i">

<p id="ii.x.vi.i-p1">The Philistines carry the ark into the temple of Dagon,
ver. 1, 2. Dagon is overthrown, ver. 3-5. The men of Ashdod and Gath
plagued, ver. 6-9. The Philistines determine to send it back, ver.
10-12.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="58.44%" prev="ii.x.vi.i" next="ii.x.vii" id="ii.x.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.x.vi.ii-p1">2. By Dagon - By way of reproach, as a spoil and trophy
set there to the honour of Dagon, to whom doubtless they ascribed this
victory.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vi.ii-p2">3. They - The priests of Dagon. Set him - Supposing his
fall was casual.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vi.ii-p3">4. Cut off - The head is the seat of wisdom; the hands
the instruments of action: both are cut off to shew that he had neither
wisdom nor strength to defend himself or his worshippers. Thus the
priests by concealing Dagon's shame before, make it more evident and
infamous. The stump - Hebrew. only dagon, that is, that part of it from
which it was called Dagon, namely the fishy part, for Dag in Hebrew
signifies a fish. It - Upon the threshold; there the trunk abode in the
place where it fell, but the head and hands were slung to distant
places.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vi.ii-p4">5. This day - When this history was written, which if
written by Samuel towards the end of his life, was a sufficient ground
for this expression.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vi.ii-p5">6. Emerods - The piles.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vi.ii-p6">8. To Gath - Supposing that this plague was confined to
Ashdod for some particular reasons, or that it came upon them by chance,
or for putting it into Dagon's temple, which they resolved they would
not do.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vi.ii-p7">9. Hidden parts - In the inwards of their hinder parts:
which is the worst kind of emerods, as all physicians acknowledge, both
because its pains are far more sharp than the other; and because the
malady is more out of the reach of remedies.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vi.ii-p8">11. The city - In every city, where the ark of God
came.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="58.47%" prev="ii.x.vi.ii" next="ii.x.vii.i" id="ii.x.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. VI" id="ii.x.vii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="58.47%" prev="ii.x.vii" next="ii.x.vii.ii" id="ii.x.vii.i">

<p id="ii.x.vii.i-p1">The Philistines send the ark back, ver. 1-12. The
Israelites receive it, ver. 13-18. The people of Beth-shemesh, smitten
for looking into the ark, desire those of Kirjath-jearim to fetch it,
ver. 19-21.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="58.47%" prev="ii.x.vii.i" next="ii.x.viii" id="ii.x.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p1">1. Seven months - So long they kept it, as loath to lose
so great a prize, and willing to try all ways to keep it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p2">3. It shall be known - You shall understand, what is
hitherto doubtful, whether he was the author of these calamities, and
why they continued so long upon you.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p3">4. Emerods - Figures representing the disease. These they
offered not in contempt of God, for they fought to gain his favour
hereby; but in testimony of their humiliation, that by leaving this
monument of their own shame and misery, they might obtain pity from God.
Mice - Which marred their land by destroying the fruits thereof; as the
other plague afflicted their Bodies.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p4">5. Give glory - The glory of his power in conquering you,
who seemed to have conquered him; of his justice in punishing you, and
of his goodness if he relieve you.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p5">6. Wherefore, &amp;c. - They express themselves thus,
either because some opposed the sending home the ark, though most had
consented to it; or because they thought they would hardly send it away
in the manner prescribed, by giving glory to God, and taking shame to
themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p6">7. Milch kine, &amp;c. - In respect to the ark; and for
the better discovery, because such untamed heifers are apt to wander,
and keep no certain and constant paths, as oxen accustomed to the yoke
do, and therefore were most unlikely to keep the direct road to Israel's
land. From them - Which would stir up natural affection in their dams,
and cause them rather to return home, than to go to a strange
country.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p7">9. His own coast - Or Border, that is, the way that
leadeth to his coast, or border, namely, the country to which it
belongs. Then he, &amp;c. - Which they might well conclude, if such
heifers should against their common use, and natural instinct, go into a
strange path, and regularly and constantly proceed in it, without any
man's conduct.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p8">12. Beth-shemesh - A city of the priests, who were by
office to take care of it. Loving - Testifying at once both their
natural and vehement inclination to their calves, and the supernatural
power which over-ruled them to a contrary course. The lords went - To
prevent all imposture, and to get assurance of the truth of the event.
All which circumstances tended to the greater illustration of God's
glory.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p9">14. They - Not the lords of the Philistines, but the
Beth-shemites, the priest that dwelt there. Offered the kine - There may
seem to be a double error in this act. First, that they offered females
for a burnt-offering, contrary to <scripRef passage="Levit i. 3" id="ii.x.vii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Lev|1|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.1.3">Levit i, 3</scripRef>. Secondly, that they did it in a forbidden place, <scripRef passage="Deut. xii. 5, 6" id="ii.x.vii.ii-p9.2" parsed="|Deut|12|5|12|6" osisRef="Bible:Deut.12.5-Deut.12.6">Deut. xii, 5, 6</scripRef>. But this case being extraordinary, may in some sort excuse
it, if they did not proceed by ordinary rules.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p10">18. Villages - This is added for explication of that
foregoing phrase, all the cities; either to shew, that under the name of
the five cities were comprehended all the villages and territories
belonging to them, in whose name, and at whose charge these presents
were made; or to express the difference between this and the former
present, the emerods being only five, according to the five cities
mentioned, ver. 17, because it may seem, the cities only, or
principally, were pestered with that disease; and the mice being many
more according to the number of all the cities, as is here expressed:
the word city being taken generally so, as to include not only fenced
cities, but also the country villages, and the fields belonging to them.
Abel - This is mentioned as the utmost border of the Philistines
territory, to which the plague of mice extended. And this place is here
called Abel, by anticipation from the great mourning mentioned in the
following verse. It is desirable, to see the ark in its habitation, in
all the circumstances of solemnity. But it is better to have it on a
great stone, and in the fields of the wood, than to be without it. The
intrinsic grandeur of divine ordinances ought not to be diminished in
our eyes, by the meanness and poverty of the place, where they are
administered.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p11">19. Had looked - Having now an opportunity which they
never yet had, it is not strange they had a vehement curiosity to see
the contents of the ark. Of the people - In and near Beth-shemesh and
coming from all parts on this occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p12">20. Who is able, &amp;c. - That is, to minister before
the ark where the Lord is present. Since God is so severe to mark what
is amiss in his servants, who is sufficient to serve him? It seems to be
a complaint, or expostulation with God, concerning this great instance
of his severity. And to whom, &amp;c. - Who will dare to receive the ark
with so much hazard to themselves. Thus when the word of God works with
terror on men's consciences, instead of taking the blame to themselves,
they frequently quarrel with the word, and endeavour to put it from
them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.vii.ii-p13">21. Kirjath-jearim - Whither they sent, either because
the place was not far off from them, and so it might soon be removed: or
because it was a place of eminency and strength, and somewhat farther
distant from the Philistines, where therefore it was likely to be better
preserved from any new attempts of the Philistines, and to be better
attended by the Israelites, who would more freely and frequently come to
it at such a place, than in Beth-shemesh, which was upon the border of
their enemies land.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="58.56%" prev="ii.x.vii.ii" next="ii.x.viii.i" id="ii.x.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. VII" id="ii.x.viii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="58.56%" prev="ii.x.viii" next="ii.x.viii.ii" id="ii.x.viii.i">

<p id="ii.x.viii.i-p1">The ark remains at Kirjath-jearim twenty years, ver. 1,
2. Samuel reforms Israel from idolatry, and Judg. Israel, ver. 3-6. The
Philistines come up against Israel, are overthrown, and restore the
cities they had taken, ver. 7-14. Samuel administers justice thro' all
the land, ver. 15-17.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="58.57%" prev="ii.x.viii.i" next="ii.x.ix" id="ii.x.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p1">1. Fetch up - That is, by the priests appointed to that
work. Hill - This place they chose, both because it was a strong place,
where it would be the most safe; and an high place, and therefore
visible at some distance, which was convenient for them, who were at
that time to direct their prayers and faces towards the ark. And for the
same reason David afterwards placed it in the hill of Zion. Sanctified
Eleazar - Not that they made him either Levite or Priest; for in Israel
persons were not made but born such; but they devoted, or set him apart
wholly to attend upon this work. His son - Him they chose rather than
his father, because he was younger and stronger, and probably freed from
domestic cares, which might divert him from, or disturb him in this
work. To keep the ark - To keep the place where it was, clean, and to
guard it that none might touch it, but such as God allowed to do so.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p2">2. Kirjath-jearim - Where it continued, and was not
carried to Shiloh its former place, either because that place was
destroyed by the Philistines when the ark was taken, or because God
would hereby punish the wickedness of the people of Israel, by keeping
it in a private place near the Philistines, whether the generality of
the people durst not come. Twenty years - He saith not, that this twenty
years was all the time of the ark's abode there, for it continued there
from Eli's time 'till David's reign, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. vi. 2" id="ii.x.viii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Sam|6|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.6.2">2 Sam. vi, 2</scripRef>, which was forty years: but that it was so long there before
the Israelites were sensible of their sin and misery. Lamented - That
is, they followed after God with Lamentations for his departure, and
prayers for his return.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p3">3. Spake - To all the rulers and people too, as he had
occasion in his circuit, described below, mixing exhortation to
repentance, with his judicial administrations. If - If you do indeed
what you profess, if you are resolved to go on in that which you seem to
have begun. With all your heart - Sincerely and in good earnest. Put -
Out of your houses, where some of you keep them; and out of your hearts,
where they still have an interest in many of you. Ashtaroth - And
especially, Ashtaroth, whom they, together with the neighbouring
nations, did more eminently worship. Prepare your hearts - By purging
them from all sin, and particularly from all inclinations to other
gods.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p4">6. Poured it out - As an external sign, whereby they
testified, both their own filthiness and need of washing by the grace
and Spirit of God, and blood of the covenant, and their sincere desire
to pour out their hearts before the Lord, in true repentance, and to
cleanse themselves from all filthiness of flesh and spirit. Before the
Lord - That is, in the public assembly, where God is in a special manner
present. Judged - That is, governed them, reformed all abuses against
God or man, took care that the laws of God should be observed, and
wilful transgressions punished.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p5">7. Went up - With an army, suspecting the effects of
their general convention, and intending to nip them in the bud. Afraid -
Being a company of unarmed persons, and unfit for battle. When sinners
begin to repent and reform, they must expect Satan will muster all his
forces against them, and set his instruments at work to the uttermost,
to oppose and discourage them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p6">8. Cease not, &amp;c. - We are afraid to look God in the
face, because of our great wickedness: do thou therefore intercede for
us, as Moses did for his generation. They had reason to expect this,
because he had promised to pray for them, had promised them deliverance
from the Philistines, and they had been observant of him, in all that he
had spoken to them from the Lord. Thus they who receive Christ as their
lawgiver and judge, need not doubt of their interest in his
intercession. O what a comfort is it to all believers, that he never
ceaseth, but always appears in the presence of God for us.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p7">9. Cried - And he cried unto the Lord. He made
intercession with the sacrifice. So Christ intercedes in virtue of his
satisfaction. And in all our prayers we must have an eye to his great
oblation, depending on him for audience and acceptance.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p8">12. A stone - A rude unpolished stone, which was not
prohibited by that law, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxvi. 1" id="ii.x.viii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Lev|26|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.26.1">Lev. xxvi, 1</scripRef>, there being no danger of worshipping such a stone, and this
being set up only as a monument of the victory. Eben-ezer - That is, the
stone of help. And this victory was gained in the very same place where
the Israelites received their former fatal loss. Helped us - He hath
begun to help us, though not compleatly to deliver us. By which wary
expression, he exciteth both their thankfulness for their mercy
received, and their holy fear and care to please and serve the Lord,
that he might help and deliver them effectually.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p9">13. Came no more - That is, with a great host, but only
with straggling parties, or garrisons. All the days, &amp;c. - All the
days of Samuel that is, while Samuel was their sole judge, or ruler; for
in Saul's time they did come.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p10">14. Peace - An agreement for the cessation of all acts of
hostility. Amorites - That is, the Canaanites, often called Amorites,
because these were formerly the most valiant of all those nations, and
the first Enemies which the Israelites met with, when they went to take
possession of their land. They made this peace with the Canaanites, that
they might he more at leisure to oppose the Philistines, now their most
potent enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p11">15. Samuel judged - For though Saul was king in Samuel's
last days, yet Samuel did not cease to be a judge, being so made by
God's extraordinary call, which Saul could not destroy; and therefore
Samuel did sometimes, upon great occasions, tho' not ordinarily,
exercise the office of judge after the beginning of Saul's reign; and
the years of the rule of Saul and Samuel are joined together, <scripRef passage="Acts xiii. 20, 21" id="ii.x.viii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Acts|13|20|13|21" osisRef="Bible:Acts.13.20-Acts.13.21">Acts xiii, 20, 21</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p12">16. In all places - He went to those several places, in
compliance with the people, whose convenience he was willing to purchase
with his own trouble, as an itinerant judge and preacher; and by his
presence in several parts, he could the better observe, and rectify all
sorts of miscarriages.</p>

<p id="ii.x.viii.ii-p13">17. Built an altar - That by joining sacrifices with his
prayers, he might the better obtain direction and assistance from God
upon all emergencies. And this was done by prophetical inspiration, as
appears by God's acceptance of the sacrifices offered upon it. Indeed
Shiloh being now laid waste, and no other place yet appointed for them
to bring their offerings to, the law which obliged them to one place,
was for the present suspended. Therefore, as the patriarchs did, he
built an altar where he lived: and that not only for the use of his own
family, but for the good of the country who resorted to it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="58.69%" prev="ii.x.viii.ii" next="ii.x.ix.i" id="ii.x.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. VIII" id="ii.x.ix-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="58.69%" prev="ii.x.ix" next="ii.x.ix.ii" id="ii.x.ix.i">

<p id="ii.x.ix.i-p1">Samuel's decay and the degeneracy of his sons, ver. 1-3.
The people petition him for a king, who refers it to God, ver. 4-6. God
directs him what answer to give, ver. 7-18. They insist upon their
petition, ver. 19, 20. Which he promises, shall be granted, ver. 21,
22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="58.69%" prev="ii.x.ix.i" next="ii.x.x" id="ii.x.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p1">1. Old - And so unfit for his former travels and labours.
He is not supposed to have been now above sixty years of age. But he had
spent his strength and spirits in the fatigue of public business: and
now if he thinks to shake himself as at other times, he finds he is
mistaken: age has cut his hair. They that are in the prime of their
years, ought to be busy in doing the work of life: for as they go into
years, they will find themselves less disposed to it, and less capable
of it. Judges - Not supreme Judges, for such there was to be but one,
and that of God's chusing; and Samuel still kept that office in his own
hands, chap. vii, 15, but his deputies, to go about and determine
matters, but with reservation of a right of appeals to himself. He had
doubtless instructed them in a singular manner, and fitted them for the
highest employments; and he hoped that the example he had sent them, and
the authority he still had over them, would oblige them to diligence and
faithfulness in their trust.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p2">2. Beer-sheba - In the southern border of the land of
Canaan, which were very remote from his house at Ramah; where, and in
the neighbouring places Samuel himself still executing the office of
judge.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p3">3. Took bribes - Opportunity and temptation discovered
that corruption in them which 'till now was hid from their father. It
has often been the grief of holy men, that their children did not tread
in their steps. So far from it, that the sons of eminently good men,
have been often eminently wicked.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p4">5. A king - Their desires exceed their reasons, which
extended no farther than to the removal of Samuel's sons from their
places, and the procuring some other just: and prudent assistance to
Samuel's age. Nor was the grant of their desire a remedy for their
disease, but rather an aggravation of it. For the sons of their king
were likely to be as corrupt as Samuel's sons and, if they were, would
not be so easily removed. Like other nations - That is, as most of the
nations about us have. But there was not the like reason; because God
had separated them from all other nations, and cautioned them against
the imitation of their examples, and had taken them into his own
immediate care and government; which privilege other nations had
not.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p5">6. Displeased - Because God was hereby dishonoured by
that distrust of him, and that ambition, and itch after changes, which
were the manifest causes of this desire; and because of that great
misery, which he foresaw the people would hereby bring upon themselves.
Prayed - For the pardon of their sin, and direction and help from God in
this great affair.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p6">7. Hearken - God grants their desire in anger, and for
their punishment. Rejected me - This injury and contumely, reflects
chiefly upon me and my government. Should not reign - By my immediate
government, which was the great honour, safety, and happiness of this
people, if they had had hearts to prize it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p7">8. So do they - Thou farest no worse than myself. This he
speaks for Samuel's comfort and vindication.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p8">9. Ye protest - That, if it be possible, thou mayst yet
prevent their sin and misery. The manner - That is, of the kings which
they desire like the kings of other nations.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p9">11. Will take - Injuriously and by violence.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p10">12. Will appoint - Hebrew. To, or for himself; for his
own fancy, or glory, and not only when the necessities of the kingdom
require it. And though this might seem to be no incumbrance, but an
honour to the persons so advanced, yet even in them that honour was
accompanied with great dangers, and pernicious snares of many kinds,
which those faint shadows of glory could not recompense; and as to the
public, their pomp and power proved very burdensome to the people, whose
lands and fruits were taken from them, and bestowed upon these, for the
support of their state. Will set them - At his own pleasure, when
possibly their own fields required all their time and pains. He will
press them for all sorts of his work, and that upon his own terms.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p11">13. Daughters - Which would be more grievous to their
parents, and more dangerous to themselves, because of the tenderness of
that sex, and their liableness to many injuries.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p12">14. Your fields - By fraud or force, as Ahab did from
Naboth. His servants - He will not only take the fruits of your lands
for his own use, but will take away your possessions to give to his
servants.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p13">15. The tenth - Besides the several tenths which God hath
reserved for his service, he will, when he pleaseth, impose another
tenth upon you. Officers - Hebrew. To his eunuchs, which may imply a
farther injury, that he should against the command of God, make some of
his people eunuchs; and take those into his court and favour, which God
would have cast out of the congregation.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p14">16. Will take - By constraint, and without sufficient
recompense.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p15">17. His servants - That is, he will use you like slaves,
and deprive you of that liberty which now you enjoy.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p16">18. Cry out - Ye shall bitterly mourn for the sad effects
of this inordinate desire of a king. Will not hear - Because you will
not hear, nor obey his counsel in this day.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p17">20. Be like - What stupidity! It was their happiness that
they were unlike all other nations, <scripRef passage="Num. xxiii. 9" id="ii.x.ix.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Num|23|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.23.9">Num. xxiii, 9</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxiii. 28" id="ii.x.ix.ii-p17.2" parsed="|Deut|33|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.33.28">Deut. xxxiii, 28</scripRef>, as in other glorious privileges, so especially in this,
that the Lord was their immediate king and lawgiver. But they will have
a king to go out before them, and to fight their battles. Could they
desire a battle better fought for them than the last was, by Samuel's
prayers and God's thunders? Were they fond to try the chance of war, at
the same uncertainty that others did? And what was the issue? Their
first king was slain in battle: and so was Joshua, one of the last and
best.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p18">21. Rehearsed - He repeated them privately between God
and himself; for his own vindication and comfort: and as a foundation
for his prayers to God, for direction and assistance.</p>

<p id="ii.x.ix.ii-p19">22. Go - Betake yourselves to your several occasions,
till you hear more from me in this matter.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="58.80%" prev="ii.x.ix.ii" next="ii.x.x.i" id="ii.x.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. IX" id="ii.x.x-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="58.80%" prev="ii.x.x" next="ii.x.x.ii" id="ii.x.x.i">

<p id="ii.x.x.i-p1">A short account of Saul, ver. 1, 2. Seeking his father's
asses, he is advised to consult Samuel, ver. 3-10. He is directed to
him, ver. 11-14. Samuel being informed of God concerning him, treats him
with respect, and prepares him for the news, that he must be king, ver.
15-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="58.80%" prev="ii.x.x.i" next="ii.x.xi" id="ii.x.x.ii">

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p1">2. Goodly - Comely and personable. Higher - A tall
stature was much valued in a king in ancient times, and in the eastern
countries.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p2">3. The asses - Which were there of great price, because
of the scarcity of horses, and therefore not held unworthy of Saul's
seeking, at least in those ancient times, when simplicity, humility, and
industry were in fashion among persons of quality.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p3">6. honourable men - One of great reputation for his skill
and faithfulness. Acquaintance with God and serviceableness to the
kingdom of God, makes men truly honourable. The way - The course we
should take to find the asses. He saith, peradventure, because he
doubted whether so great a prophet would seek, or God would grant him a
Revelation concerning such mean matters: although sometimes God was
pleased herein to condescend to his people, to cut off all pretense or
occasion of seeking to heathenish divination.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p4">7. A present - Presents were then made to the prophets,
either as a testimony of respect: or, as a grateful acknowledgement: or,
for the support of the Prophets themselves: or, of the sons of the
prophets: or, of other persons in want, known to them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p5">9. Seer - Because he discerned and could discover things
secret and unknown to others. And these are the words, either of some
later sacred writer, who after Samuel's death, inserted this verse. Or,
of Samuel, who, being probably fifty or sixty years old at the writing
of this book, and speaking of the state of things in his first days,
might well call it before time.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p6">12. Came today to the city - He had been travelling
abroad, and was now returned to his own house in Ramah. High place -
Upon the hill mentioned ver. 11, and near the altar which Samuel built
for this use.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p7">13. Find him - At home and at leisure. To eat - The
relicks of the sacrifices. Doth bless - The blessing of this sacrifice
seems to have consisted both of thanksgiving, this being a
thank-offering, and of prayer to God for its acceptance.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p8">15. His ear - That is, secretly, perhaps by a still small
voice.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p9">16. Philistines - For though they were now most pressed
with the Ammonites, yet they looked upon these as a land-flood, soon up,
and soon down again: but the Philistines, their constant and nearest
enemies, they most dreaded. And from these did Saul in some measure save
them, and would have saved them much more, if his and the people's sins
had not hindered.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p10">20. On whom - Who is he that shall be that, which all
Israel desire to have, namely, a king. Father's house - That honour is
designed for thee, and, after thy death, for thy family or posterity, is
by thy sin thou dost not cut off the entail.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p11">21. The smallest - For so indeed this was, having been
all cut off except six hundred, <scripRef passage="Judg. xx. 46-48" id="ii.x.x.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Judg|20|46|20|48" osisRef="Bible:Judg.20.46-Judg.20.48">Judg. xx, 46-48</scripRef>, which blow they never recovered, and therefore they were
scarce reckoned as an entire tribe, but only as a remnant of a tribe;
and being ingrafted into Judah, in the division between the ten tribes
and the two, they in some sort lost their name, and together with Judah
were accounted but one tribe.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p12">22. Chief place - Thereby to raise their expectation, and
to prepare them for giving that honour to Saul, which his approaching
dignity required.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p13">24. I said - When I first spake that I had invited the
people to join with me in my sacrifice, and then to partake with me of
the feast, I then bade the cook reserve this part for thy use.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p14">25. Communed - Concerning the kingdom designed for him by
God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.x.ii-p15">27. Pass on - That thou and I may speak privately of the
matter or the kingdom. Which Samuel hitherto endeavoured to conceal,
lest he should be thought now to impose a king upon them, as before he
denied one to them; and that it might appear by the lot mentioned in the
next chapter, that the kingdom was given to Saul by God's destination,
and not by Samuel's contrivance. Word of God - That is, a message
delivered to me from God, which now I shall impart to thee.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="58.87%" prev="ii.x.x.ii" next="ii.x.xi.i" id="ii.x.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. X" id="ii.x.xi-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="58.87%" prev="ii.x.xi" next="ii.x.xi.ii" id="ii.x.xi.i">

<p id="ii.x.xi.i-p1">The anointing of Saul, ver. 1. Samuel gives him signs and
instruction, ver. 2-8. The signs accomplished, ver. 9-13. His return to
his father's house, ver. 14-16. He is elected, solemnly inaugurated, and
returns to his own city, ver. 17-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="58.88%" prev="ii.x.xi.i" next="ii.x.xii" id="ii.x.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p1">1. Poured it - Which Is was the usual rite in the
designation, as of priests and prophets, so also of kings, whereby was
signified the pouring forth of the gifts of God's spirit upon him, to
fit him for the administration of his office. These sacred unctions then
used, pointed at the great Messiah, or anointed One, the King of the
church, and High-priest of our profession, who was anointed with the oil
of the spirit without measure, above all the priests and princes of the
Jewish church. Kissed - As a testimony of his sincere friendship and
affection to him. His inheritance - That is, over his own peculiar
people. Whereby he admonisheth Saul, that this people were not so much
his, as God's; and that he was not to rule them according his own will,
but according to the will of God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p2">2. Rachel's sepulchre - In the way to Bethlehem, which
city was in Judah; her sepulchre might be either in Judah, or in
Benjamin; for the possessions of those two tribes were bordering one
upon another. The first place he directs him to was a sepulchre, the
sepulchre of one of his ancestors. There he must read a lecture of his
own mortality, and now he had a crown in his eye, must think of his
grave, in which all his honour would be laid in the dust.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p3">3. Plain - Not that at the foot of mount Tabor, which was
far from these parts; but another belonging to some other place. Bethel
- Properly so called, which was in Ephraim, where there was a noted
high-place, famous for Jacob's vision there, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxviii. 19" id="ii.x.xi.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Gen|28|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.28.19">Gen. xxviii, 19</scripRef>, where it is probable they offered sacrifices, in this
confused state of things, when the ark was in one place, and the
tabernacle in another.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p4">5. Prophets - By prophets he understands persons that
wholly devoted themselves to religious studies and exercises. For the
term of prophesying is not only given to the most eminent act of it,
foretelling things to come; but also to preaching, and to the making or
singing of psalms, or songs of praise to God. And they that wholly
attended upon these things, are called sons of the prophets, who were
commonly combined into companies or colleges, that they might more
conveniently assist one another in God's work. This institution God was
pleased so far to honour and bless, that sometimes he communicated unto
those persons the knowledge of future things. Psaltery - Such
instruments of musick being then used by prophets and other persons, for
the excitation of their spirits in God's service. Prophesy - Either sing
God's praises, or speak of the things of God, by a peculiar impulse of
his spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p5">6. Will come - Hebrew. will leap, or rush upon thee.
Another man - That is, thou shalt be suddenly endowed with another
spirit, filled with skill of divine things, with courage, and wisdom,
and magnanimity; and other qualifications befitting thy dignity.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p6">7. Thou do - Hebrew. do what they hand findeth to do;
that is, as thou shalt have a call and opportunity. He doth not intend
that he should take the kingly government upon him, before his call to
it was owned by the people, but that he should dispose his mind to a
readiness of undertaking any public service when he should be called to
his office.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p7">8. Till I come - This, though now mentioned and
commanded, was not immediately to be performed; as is evident, partly
from the whole course of the story, (which shews, that Saul and Samuel,
and the people, first met at Mizpeh, ver. 17, &amp;c. where Saul was
chosen by God, and accepted by the people as king; and afterwards went
to Gilgal once before the time here spoken of, chap. xi, 14, 15,) and
partly, by comparing this place with chap. xiii, 8, &amp;c. where we
find Saul charged with the violation of this command, two years after
the giving of it. It seems this is given as a standing rule for Saul to
observe while Samuel and he lived; that in case of any great future
difficulties, as the invasion of enemies, Saul should resort to Gilgal,
and call the people thither, and tarry there seven days, which was but a
necessary time for gathering the people, and for the coming of Samuel
thither. And Gilgal was chosen for this purpose, because that place was
famous for the solemn renewing of the covenant between God and Israel, <scripRef passage="Josh. iv. 19-24" id="ii.x.xi.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Josh|4|19|4|24" osisRef="Bible:Josh.4.19-Josh.4.24">Josh.
iv, 19-24</scripRef>, and for other eminent instances of God's favour to them,
the remembrance whereof was a confirmation of their faith; and because
it was a very convenient place for he tribes within and without Jordan
to assemble, and consult, and unite their forces together upon such
occasions.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p8">10. Prophesied - The accomplishment of the two former
signs is supposed, and this only is expressed, because this was more
eminent than the former; the other were only transient acts, which
passed in private between two or three persons meeting together; but
this was a more permanent and notorious sign, done in a more solemn
manner, and before many witnesses.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p9">11. Is Saul - A man never instructed, nor exercised in,
nor inclined to these matters.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p10">12. Who is, &amp;c. - Who is the father of all these
prophets, among whom Saul now is one? Who is it that instructs and
inspires them but God? They have it not from their parents, nor from
their education, but by inspiration from God, who, when he pleaseth, can
inspire Saul, or any other man with the same skill. And therefore wonder
not at this matter, but give God the glory of it. A proverb - Used when
any strange, or unexpected thing happened.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p11">13. High place - Returning thither with the prophets, to
praise God for these wonderful favours, and to beg counsel and help from
God in this high business.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p12">16. Told not - In obedience to Samuel, who obliged him to
secrecy: and from an humble modesty.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p13">19. Now therefore, &amp;c. - He puts them upon chusing
their king by lot, that all might know God had chosen Saul (for the
disposal of the lot is of the Lord) and to prevent all dispute and
exception.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p14">20. Benjamin - Which tribe was now preferred before
Judah, because the kingdom was freely promised by God to Judah, and was
to be given to him in love; but now the kingdom was in a manner forced
from God, and given them in anger and therefore conferred upon an
obscure tribe.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p15">22. Inquired - Either by Urim or Thummim, which was the
usual way of enquiry. Or, by Samuel, who by his prayer procured an
answer. Stuff - Among the carriages or baggage of the people there
assembled. This he probably did, from a sense of his own
unworthiness.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p16">24. None like him - As to the height of his bodily
stature, which was in itself, commendable in a king, and some kind of
indication of great endowments of mind. God save the king - Hebrew. let
the king live; that is, long and prosperously. Hereby they accept him
for their king, and promise subjection to him. None will be losers in
the end by their humility and modesty. honour, like the shadows, follows
them that flee from it, but flees from them that pursue it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p17">25. Manner of the kingdom - The laws and rules by which
the kingly government was to be managed; agreeable to those mentioned <scripRef passage="Deut. xvii. 16" id="ii.x.xi.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Deut|17|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.17.16">Deut. xvii, 16</scripRef>, &amp;c. Before the Lord - Before the ark, where it was kept
safe from depravation.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p18">26. Went home - Not being actually inaugurated into his
kingdom, he thought fit to retire to his former habitation, and to live
privately 'till he had an occasion to shew himself in a more illustrious
manner. Then went - To give him safe and honourable conduct to his
house, though not to abide with him there, which did not suit his
present circumstance.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xi.ii-p19">27. No presents - As subjects in those times used to do
to their kings. This was an evidence both of his humility, and the
mercifulness of his disposition. So Christ held his peace, in the day of
his patience. But there is a day of recompense coming.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="59.01%" prev="ii.x.xi.ii" next="ii.x.xii.i" id="ii.x.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XI" id="ii.x.xii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="59.01%" prev="ii.x.xii" next="ii.x.xii.ii" id="ii.x.xii.i">

<p id="ii.x.xii.i-p1">The distress of Jabesh-gilead, ver. 1-3. Saul's readiness
to relieve them, and success, ver. 4-11. His tenderness to them that
opposed him, ver. 12-13. He is confirmed in his kingdom, ver. 14-
15.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="59.01%" prev="ii.x.xii.i" next="ii.x.xiii" id="ii.x.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xii.ii-p1">1. Then - That is, about that time; for that this
happened before, and was the occasion of their desire of a king, may
seem from chap. xii, 12, although it is possible, that Nahash's
preparation, might cause that desire, and that he did not actually come
'till their king was chosen. Will serve - The occasion of this offer
was, that they saw no likelihood of relief from their brethren in
Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xii.ii-p2">2. Thrust out, &amp;c. - Partly for a reproach, as it
here follows; and partly, to disable them. He leaves them one eye, that
they might be fit to serve in any mean and base office.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xii.ii-p3">5. After the herd - For being only anointed king, and not
publickly inaugurated, nor having yet had opportunity of doing any thing
worthy of his place, he thought fit to forbear all royal state, and to
retire to his former private life, which, howsoever despised in this
latter ages, was anciently in great esteem. Good magistrates are in
pain, if their subjects are in tears.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xii.ii-p4">7. Sent them - Wisely considering, that the sight of mens
eyes does much more affect their hearts, than what they only hear with
their ears. Samuel - Whom he joins with himself, both because he was
present with him; and that hereby he might gain the more authority. Fear
- A fear sent upon them by God, that they should not dare to deny their
help. The fear of God will make men good subjects, good soldiers, and
good friends to their country. They that fear God will make conscience
of their duty to all men, particularly to their rulers.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xii.ii-p5">8. Men of Judah - Who are numbered apart to their honour,
to shew how readily they, to whom the kingdom was promised, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 10" id="ii.x.xii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Gen|49|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.10">Gen.
xlix, 10</scripRef>, submitted to their king, though of another tribe; and how
willing they were to hazard themselves for their brethren although they
might have excused themselves from the necessity of defending their own
country from their dangerous neighbours the Philistines.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xii.ii-p6">14. Then - While the people were together by
Jabesh-gilead, wherein Samuel's great prudence and fidelity to Saul is
evident. He suspended the confirmation of Saul at first, whilst the
generality of the people were disaffected, and now when he had given
such eminent proof of his princely virtues, and when the peoples hearts
were eagerly set upon him, he takes this as the fittest season for that
work. Renew - That is, confirm our former choice.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xii.ii-p7">15. Made - They owned and accepted him for their
king.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="59.06%" prev="ii.x.xii.ii" next="ii.x.xiii.i" id="ii.x.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XII" id="ii.x.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="59.06%" prev="ii.x.xiii" next="ii.x.xiii.ii" id="ii.x.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.x.xiii.i-p1">Samuel clears himself from all imputation of abusing the
power which he now resigns to Saul, ver. 1-5. He reminds them of the
great things God had done, ver. 6-13. He sets before them the blessing
and the curse, ver. 14, 15. He calls upon God for thunder, ver. 16-19.
He encourages and exhorts them, ver. 20-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="59.06%" prev="ii.x.xiii.i" next="ii.x.xiv" id="ii.x.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p1">1. Said - While they were assembled together in Gilgal.
And this is another instance of Samuel's great wisdom and integrity. He
would not reprove the people for their sin, in desiring a king, whilst
Saul was unsettled in his kingdom; lest through their accustomed levity,
they should as hastily cast off their king, as they had passionately
desired him, and therefore he chuseth this season for it; because Saul's
kingdom was now confirmed by an eminent victory; and because the people
rejoiced greatly, applauded themselves for their desires of a king; and
interpreted the success which God had given them, as a divine
approbation of those desires. Samuel therefore thinks fit to temper
their joys, and to excite them to that repentance which he saw wanting
in them, and which he knew to be necessary, to prevent the curse of God
upon their new king, and the whole kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p2">2. Walketh - Ruleth over you. To him I have fully
resigned my power, and own myself one of his subjects. Old - And
therefore unable to bear the burden of government. My sons - Or, among
you, in the same states private persons, as you are; if they have
injured any of you, the law is now open against them; any of you may
accuse them, your king can punish them, I do not intercede for them.
Walked before you - That is, been your guide and governor; partly, as a
prophet; and partly, as a judge.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p3">3. Behold - I here present myself before the Lord, and
before your king, ready to give an account of all my administrations.
And this protestation Samuel makes of his integrity, not out of
ostentation; but for his own just vindication, that the people might not
hereafter for the defense of their own irregularities, reproach his
government, and that being publickly acquitted from all faults in his
government, he might more freely reprove the sins of the people, and,
particularly, that sin of theirs in desiring a king, when they had so
little reason for it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p4">7. Righteous acts - Hebrew. the righteousnesses; that is,
mercies or benefits the chief subject of the following discourse; some
of their calamities being but briefly named, and that for the
illustration of God's mercy in their deliverances.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p5">8. This place - In this land: in which Moses and Aaron
are said to settle them; because they brought them into, and seated them
in part of it, that without Jordan; because they were, under God, the
principal authors of their entering into the land of Canaan; inasmuch as
they brought them out of Egypt, conducted them through the wilderness;
and thereby their prayers to God, and counsel to them, preserved them
from ruin, and gave command from God for the distribution of the land
among them, and encouraged them to enter into it. And lastly, Moses
substituted Josh. in his stead, and commanded him to seat them there,
which he did.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p6">9. Forgat - That is, they revolted from him, and carried
themselves, as if they had wholly forgotten his innumerable favours.
This he saith to answer an objection, that the reason why they desired a
king, was, because in the time of the Judges they were at great
uncertainties, and often exercised with sharp afflictions: to which he
answereth by concession that they were so; but adds, by way of
retortion, that they themselves were the cause of it, by their
forgetting God: so that it was not the fault of that kind of government,
but their transgressing the rules of it. Fought - With success, and
subdued them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p7">11. Bedan - This was either Samson, as most interpreters
believe, who is called Bedan; that is, in Daniel, or of Daniel, one of
that tribe, to signify that they had no reason to distrust that God, who
could raise so eminent a saviour out of so obscure a tribe: or, Jair the
Gileadite, which may seem best to agree, first, with the time and order
of the Judges; for Jair was before Jephthah, but Samson was after him.
Secondly, with other scriptures: for among the sons of a more ancient
Jair, we meet with one called Bedan, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. vii. 17" id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|1Chr|7|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.7.17">1 Chron.
vii, 17</scripRef>, which name seems here given to Jair the judge, to
distinguish him from that first Jair. Safe - So that it was no
necessity, but mere wantonness, that made you desire a change.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p8">12. Your king - That is, when God was your immediate king
and governor, who was both able and willing to deliver you, if you had
cried to him, whereof you and your ancestors have had plentiful
experience; so that you did not at all need any other king; and your
desire of another, was a manifest reproach against God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p9">13. Ye have chosen - Though God chose him by lot, yet the
people are said to chuse him; either generally, because they chose that
form of government; or particularly, because they approved of God's
choice, and confirmed it. The Lord - He hath yielded to your inordinate
desire.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p10">14. Then, &amp;c. - Hebrew. then shall-ye-be, (that is,
walk, or go) after the Lord; that is, God shall still go before you, as
he hath hitherto done, as your leader or governor, to direct, protect,
and deliver you; and he will not forsake you, as you have given him just
cause to do. Sometimes this phrase of going after the Lord, signifies a
man's obedience to God; but here it is otherwise to be understood, and
it notes not a duty to be performed, but a privilege to be received upon
the performance of their duty; because it is opposed to a threatening
denounced in case of disobedience, in the next verse.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p11">15. Your fathers - Who lived under the Judges; and you
shall have no advantage by the change of government, nor shall your
kings be able to protect you against God's displeasure. The mistake, if
we think we can evade God's justice, by shaking off his dominion. If we
will not let God rule us, yet he will judge us.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p12">17. Wheat-harvest - At which time it was a rare thing in
those parts to have thunder or rain; the weather being more constant in
its seasons there, than it is with us. Rain - That you may understand
that God is displeased with you; and also how foolishly and wickedly you
have done in rejecting the government of that God, at whose command are
all things both in heaven and in earth.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p13">18. Samuel - Who had such power and favour with God. By
this thunder and rain, God shewed them their folly in desiring a king to
save them, rather than God or Samuel, expecting more from an arm of
flesh than from the arm of God, or from the power of prayer. Could their
king thunder with a voice like God? Could their prince command such
forces as the prophet could by his prayers? Likewise he intimates, that
how serene soever their condition was now, (like the weather in wheat
harvest) yet if God pleased, he could soon change the face of their
heavens, and persecute them with his storms.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p14">19. Thy God - Whom thou hast so great an interest in,
while we are ashamed and afraid to call him our God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p15">20. Fear not - With a desponding fear, as if there were
no hope left for you.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p16">21. Turn aside-After idols; as they had often done
before; and, notwithstanding this warning, did afterwards. Vain things -
So idols are called, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 21" id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Deut|32|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.21">Deut. xxxii, 21</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Jer. ii. 5" id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p16.2" parsed="|Jer|2|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.2.5">Jer. ii, 5</scripRef>, and so they are, being mere nothings, having no power in
them; no influence upon us, nor use or benefit to us.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p17">22. His name's sake - That is, for his own honour, which
would suffer much among men, if he should not preserve and deliver his
people in eminent dangers. And this reason God alledgeth to take them
off from all conceit of their own merit; and to assure them, that if
they did truly repent of all their sins, and serve God with all their
heart; yet even in that case their salvation would not be due to their
merits; but the effect of God's free mercy. To make - Out of his own
free grace, without any desert of yours, and therefore he will not
forsake you, except you thrust him away.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiii.ii-p18">24. Only, &amp;c. - Otherwise neither my prayer nor
counsels will stand you in any stead.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="59.20%" prev="ii.x.xiii.ii" next="ii.x.xiv.i" id="ii.x.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XIII" id="ii.x.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="59.20%" prev="ii.x.xiv" next="ii.x.xiv.ii" id="ii.x.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.x.xiv.i-p1">Saul and Jonathan's life-guard, ver. 1, 2. Jonathan
smites a garrison, and the people are called together, ver. 3, 4. The
Philistines come up, and the Israelites are terrified, ver. 5-7. Saul
sacrifices, ver. 8-10. Is reproved by Samuel, ver. 11-14. The people
diminished, plundered, and disarmed, ver. 15-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="59.21%" prev="ii.x.xiv.i" next="ii.x.xv" id="ii.x.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p1">3. Blew - That is, he sent messengers to tell them all
what Jonathan had done, and how the Philistines were enraged at it, and
therefore what necessity there was of gathering themselves together for
their own defense.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p2">4. Saul - Perhaps contrary to some treaty.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p3">5. Thirty thousand chariots, &amp;c. - Most of them, we
may suppose, carriages for their baggage, not chariots of war, tho' all
their allies were joined with them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p4">6. Strait - Notwithstanding their former presumption that
if they had a king, they should be free from all such straits. And
hereby God intended to teach them the vanity of confidence in men; and
that they did not one jot less need the help of God now, than they did
when they had no king. And probably they were the more discouraged,
because they did not find Samuel with Saul. Sooner or later men will be
made to see, that God and his prophets are their best friends.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p5">7. All the people - That is, all that were left.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p6">8. Seven days - Not seven compleat days; for the last day
was not finished.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p7">11. Camest not - That is, when the seventh day was come,
and a good part of it past, whence I concluded thou wouldst not come
that day.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p8">12. Supplication - Thence it appears, that sacrifices
were accompanied with solemn prayers. Forced myself - I did it against
my own mind and inclination.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p9">13. For ever - The phrase, forever, in scripture often
signifies only a long time. So this had been abundantly verified, if the
kingdom had been enjoyed by Saul, and by his son, and by his son's son;
after whom the kingdom might have come to Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p10">14. A man - That is, such a man as will fulfil all the
desires of his heart, and not oppose them, as thou dost. Commanded -
That is, hath appointed, as the word command is sometimes used: but
though God threatened but Saul with the loss of his kingdom for his sin;
yet it is not improbable, there was a tacit condition implied, to wit,
if he did not repent of this; and of all his sins; for the full, and
final, and peremptory sentence of Saul's rejection, is plainly ascribed
to another cause, chap. xv, 11, 23, 26, 28, 29, and 'till that second
offense, neither the spirit of the Lord departed from him, nor was David
anointed in his stead. "But was it not hard, to punish so little a sin
so severely?" It was not little: disobedience to an express command,
tho' in a small matter, is a great provocation. And indeed, there is no
little sin, because there is no little God to sin against. In general,
what to men seems a small offense, to him who knows the heart may appear
a heinous crime. We are taught hereby, how necessary it is, that we wait
on our God continually. For Saul is sentenced to lose his kingdom for
want of two or three hours patience.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p11">20. Philistines - Not to the land of the Philistines, but
to the stations and garrisons which the Philistines retained in several
parts of Israel's land, though Samuel's authority had so far over- awed
them, that they durst not give the Israelites much disturbance. In
these, therefore, the Philistines kept all the smiths; and here they
allowed them the exercise of their art for the uses following.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xiv.ii-p12">22. Sword - It seems restrained to the six hundred that
were with Saul and Jonathan; for there were no doubt a considerable
number of swords and spears among the Israelites, but they generally hid
them, as now they did their persons, from the Philistines. And the
Philistines had not yet attained to so great a power over them, as
wholly to disarm them, but thought it sufficient to prevent the making
of new arms; knowing that the old ones would shortly be decayed, and
useless. There were likewise other arms more common in those times and
places, than swords and spears; to wit, bows and arrows, and slings and
stones.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="59.27%" prev="ii.x.xiv.ii" next="ii.x.xv.i" id="ii.x.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XIV" id="ii.x.xv-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="59.27%" prev="ii.x.xv" next="ii.x.xv.ii" id="ii.x.xv.i">

<p id="ii.x.xv.i-p1">Jonathan proposes to his armour-bearer the attacking of
the Philistine's army, ver. 1-10. They make the attack; the Philistines
are terrified, ver. 11-15. They slay one another, and are pursued by the
Israelites, ver. 16-23. Saul adjures the people to eat nothing 'till
night; Jonathan eats honey, ver. 24-30. The people smite the
Philistines, and eat the spoil with the blood, ver. 31, 32. Saul
remedies this, ver. 33-35. Dooms Jonathan to death, who is rescued by
the people, ver. 36-46. A general account of Saul's exploits and family,
ver. 47-52.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="59.28%" prev="ii.x.xv.i" next="ii.x.xvi" id="ii.x.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p1">2. Tarried - In the outworks of the city where he had
entrenched himself to observe the motion of the Philistines. In - Or,
towards Migron, which was near Gibeah.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p2">3. Ahiah - The same who is called Abimelech, chap. xxii,
9, 11, 20, the high-priest, who was here to attend upon the ark which
was brought thither, ver. 18. Ephod - The high-priest's ephod, wherein
the Urim and Thummim was.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p3">4. Passages - Two passages, both which Jonathan must
cross, to go to the Philistines, between which the following rocks lay,
but the words may be rendered, in the middle of the passage, the plural
number being put for the singular. Rock - Which is not to be understood,
as if in this passage one rock was on the right hand, and the other on
the left; for so he might have gone between both: and there was no need
of climbing up to them. But the meaning is, that the tooth (or
prominency) of one rock, (as it is in the Hebrew) was on the side; that
is northward, looking towards Michmash (the garrison of the Philistines)
and the tooth of the other rock was on the other side; that is,
southward, looking towards Gibeah, (where Saul's camp lay): and Jonathan
was forced to climb over these two rocks, because the common ways from
one town to the other were obstructed.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p4">6. Uncircumcised - So he calls them, to strengthen his
faith by this consideration, that his enemies were enemies to God;
whereas he was circumcised, and therefore in covenant with God, who was
both able, and engaged to assist his people. It way be - He speaks
doubtfully: for tho' he felt himself stirred up by God to this exploit,
and was assured that God would deliver his people; yet he was not
certain that he would do it at this time, and in this way. Work - Great
and wonderful things.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p5">10. A sign - Jonathan not being assured of the success of
this exploit, desires a sign; and by the instinct of God's Spirit,
pitches upon this. Divers such motions and extraordinary impulses there
were among great and good men in ancient times. Observe; God has the
governing of the hearts and tongues of all men, even of those that know
him not, and serves his own purposes by them, tho' they mean not so,
neither does their hearts think so.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p6">12. Come up, &amp;c. - A speech of contempt and derision.
The Lord - He piously and modestly ascribes the success which he now
foresees, to God only. And he does not say, into our hand, but into the
hand of Israel; for he fought not his own glory, but the public good.
His faith being thus strengthened, nothing can stand against him: he
climbs the rock upon all four, though he had nothing to cover him, none
to second him, but his servant, nor any probability of any thing but
death before him.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p7">13. They fell - For being endowed with extraordinary
strength and courage, and having with incredible boldness killed the
first they met with, it is not strange if the Philistines were both
astonished and intimidated; God also struck them with a panic; and
withal, infatuated their minds, and possibly, put an evil spirit among
them, which in this universal confusion made them conceive that there
was treachery among themselves, and therefore caused them to sheathe
their swords in one anothers bowels.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p8">15. Field - That is, in the whole host which was in the
field. All - That is, among all the rest of their forces, as well as
those in the garrison at Michmash, as the spoilers, mentioned chap.
xiii, 17, the report of this prodigy, and with it the terror of God
speedily passing from one to another. Trembling - The Hebrew is, a
trembling of God, signifying not only a very great trembling, but such
as was supernatural, and came immediately from the hand of God. He that
made the heart knows how to make it tremble. To complete their
confusion, even the earth quaked; it shook under them, and made them
fear it was just going to swallow them up. Those who will not fear the
eternal God, he can make afraid of a shadow.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p9">19. Withdraw - Trouble not thyself to inquire; for I now
plainly discern the matter.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p10">21. Which went - Either by constraint, as servants; or in
policy, to gain their favour and protection.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p11">23. The battle - That is, the warriors who were engaged
in the battle, and were pursuing the Philistines. Yet it is said, the
Lord saved Israel that day: he did it by them: for without him they
could do nothing. Salvation is of the Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p12">24. Distressed - With hunger, and weakness, and
faintness, and all by reason of the following oath. Avenged - As Saul's
intention was good, so the matter of the obligation was not simply
unlawful, if it had not been so rigorous in excluding all food, and in
obliging the people to it under pain of an accursed death, which was a
punishment far exceeding the fault.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p13">26. Honey - Bees often make their hives in the trunks of
trees, or clefts of rocks, or holes of the earth; and this in divers
countries, but eminently in Canaan.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p14">27. Enlightened - He was refreshed, and recovered his
lost spirits. This cleared his sight, which was grown dim by hunger and
faintness.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p15">28. People - They that came with Saul, whose forces were
now united with Jonathan's.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p16">32. Slew - At evening, when the time prefixed by Saul was
expired. With blood - Not having patience to tarry 'till the blood was
perfectly gone out of them, as they should have done. So they who made
conscience of the king's commandment for fear of the curse, make no
scruple of transgressing God's command.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p17">33. Transgressed - He sees their fault, but not his own,
in giving the occasion of it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p18">36. Draw near - To the ark, in order to inquire of
God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p19">39. Answered - None of those who saw Jonathan eating,
informed against him; because they were satisfied that his ignorance
excused him; and from their great love to Jonathan, whom they would not
expose to death for so small an offense.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p20">41. Perfect lot - Or, declare the perfect, or guiltless
person. That is, O Lord, so guide the lot, that it may discover who is
guilty in his matter, and who innocent. Escaped - They were pronounced
guiltless.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p21">42. Jonathan - God so ordered the lot; not that he
approved Saul's execration, ver. 24, or his oath that the transgressor
should die, ver. 39, nor that he would expose Jonathan to death; but
that Saul's folly might be chastised, when he saw what danger it had
brought upon his eldest and excellent son; and that Jonathan's innocency
might be cleared.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p22">44. For thou,&amp;c. - We have no proof, that Saul did
not act in this whole affair from a real fear of God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p23">45. With God - In concurrence with God, he hath wrought
this salvation. God is so far from being offended with Jonathan, that he
hath graciously owned him in the great service of this day.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p24">47. Took the kingdom - That is, resumed the
administration of it, after he had in a manner lost it by the
Philistines, who had almost turned him out of it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xv.ii-p25">49. Ishui - Called also Abinadab. chap. xxxi, 2.
Ishbosheth, Saul's other son is here omitted, because he intended to
mention only those of his sons who went with him into the battles here
mentioned, and who were afterwards slain with him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="59.41%" prev="ii.x.xv.ii" next="ii.x.xvi.i" id="ii.x.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XV" id="ii.x.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="59.41%" prev="ii.x.xvi" next="ii.x.xvi.ii" id="ii.x.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.x.xvi.i-p1">God commands Saul utterly to destroy the Amalekites, ver.
1- 3. He destroys them, but not utterly, ver. 4-9. Samuel pronounces
sentence upon him for his disobedience, yet consents to honour him
before the people, ver. 10-31. Slays Agag, ver. 32, 33. Takes his leave
of Saul, yet mourns for him, ver. 34, 35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="59.41%" prev="ii.x.xvi.i" next="ii.x.xvii" id="ii.x.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p1">1. Hearken - Thou hast committed error already, now
regain God's favour by thy exact obedience to what he commands.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p2">2. I remember - Now I will revenge those old injuries of
the Amalekites on their children: who continue in their parents
practices. Came from Egypt - When he was newly come out of cruel and
long bondage, and was now weak, and weary, and faint, and hungry, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 18" id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Deut|25|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.18">Deut. xxv, 18</scripRef>, and therefore it was barbarous instead of that pity which
even Nature prompted them to afford, to add affliction to the afflicted;
it was also horrid impiety to fight against God himself and to lift up
their hand in a manner against the Lord's throne, whilst they struck at
that people which God had brought forth in so stupendous a way.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p3">3. Destroy - Both persons and goods, kill all that live,
and consume all things without life, for I will have no name nor remnant
of that people left, whom long since I have devoted to utter
destruction. Spare not - Shew no compassion or favour to any of them.
The same thing repeated to prevent mistake, and oblige Saul to the exact
performance hereof. Slay, &amp;c. - Which was not unjust, because God is
the supreme Lord of life, and can require his own when he pleaseth;
infants likewise are born in sin, and therefore liable to God's wrath.
Their death also was rather a mercy than a curse, as being the occasion
of preventing their sin and punishment. Ox, &amp;c. - Which being all
made for man's benefit, it is not strange if they suffer with him, for
the instruction of mankind.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p4">6. Kenites - A people descending from, or nearly related
to Jethro, who anciently dwelt in rocks near the Amalekites, <scripRef passage="Num. xxiv. 21" id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Num|24|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.24.21">Num. xxiv, 21</scripRef>, and afterwards some of them dwelt in Judah, <scripRef passage="Judg. i. 16" id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p4.2" parsed="|Judg|1|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.1.16">Judg. i, 16</scripRef>, whence it is probable they removed, (which, dwelling in
tents, they could easily do) and retired to their old habitation,
because of the wars and troubles wherewith Judah was annoyed. Shewed
kindness - Some of your progenitors did so, and for their sakes all of
you shall fare the better. You were not guilty of that sin for which
Amalek is now to be destroyed. When destroying judgments are abroad God
takes care to separate the precious from the vile. It is then especially
dangerous to be found in the company of God's enemies. The Jews have a
saying, Woe to a wicked man, and to his neighbour.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p5">7. To Shur - That is, from one end of their country to
the other; he smote all that he met with: but a great number of them
fled away upon the noise of his coming, and secured themselves in other
places, 'till the storm was over. 8. All - Whom he found. Now they paid
dear for the sin of their ancestors. They were themselves guilty of
idolatry and numberless sins, for which they deserved to be cut off. Yet
when God would reckon with them, he fixes upon this as the ground of his
quarrel.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p6">9. Vile - Thus they obeyed God only so far as they could
without inconvenience to themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p7">11. Repenteth - Repentance implies grief of heart, and
change of counsels, and therefore cannot be in God: but it is ascribed
to God when God alters his method of dealing, and treats a person as if
be did indeed repent of the kindness he had shewed him. All night - To
implore his pardoning mercy for Saul, and for the people. Is turned back
- Therefore he did once follow God. Otherwise it would have been
impossible, he should turn back from following him.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p8">12. A place - That is, a monument or trophy of his
victory.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p9">13. They - That is, the people. Thus, he lays the blame
upon the people; whereas they could not do it without his consent; and
he should have used his power to over-rule them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p10">18. A journey - So easy was the service, and so certain
the success, that it was rather to be called a journey than a war.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p11">20. The king - To be dealt with as God pleaseth.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p12">21. But the people, &amp;c. - Here the conscience of Saul
begins to awake, tho' but a little: for he still lays the blame on the
people.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p13">22. Sacrifice - Because obedience to God is a moral duty,
constantly and indispensably necessary; but sacrifice is but a
ceremonial institution, sometimes unnecessary, as it was in the
wilderness: and sometimes sinful, when it is offered by a polluted hand,
or in an irregular manner. Therefore thy gross disobedience to God's
express command, is not to be compensated with sacrifice. Hearken - That
is, to obey. Fat - Then the choicest part of all the sacrifice.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p14">23. Rebellion - Disobedience to God's command.
Stubbornness - Contumacy in sin, justifying it, and pleading for it.
Iniquity - Or, the iniquity of idolatry. Rejected - Hath pronounced the
sentence of rejection: for that he was not actually deposed by God
before, plainly appears, because not only the people, but even David,
after this, owned him as king. Those are unworthy to rule over men, who
are not willing that God should rule over them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p15">24. I have sinned - It does by no means appear, that Saul
acts the hypocrite herein, in assigning a false cause of his
disobedience. Rather, he nakedly declares the thing as it was.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p16">25. Pardon my sin - Neither can it be proved that there
was any hypocrisy in this. Rather charity requires us to believe, that
he sincerely desired pardon, both from God and man, as he now knew, he
had sinned against both.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p17">26. I will not - This was no lie, though he afterwards
returned, because he spoke what he meant; his words and his intentions
agreed together, though afterwards he saw reason to change his
intentions. Compare <scripRef passage="Gen. xix. 2, 3" id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Gen|19|2|19|3" osisRef="Bible:Gen.19.2-Gen.19.3">Gen. xix, 2, 3</scripRef>. This may relieve many perplexed consciences, who think
themselves obliged to do what they have said they would do, though they
see just cause to change their minds. Hath rejected thee, &amp;c. - But
he does not say, he "hath rejected thee from salvation." And who besides
hath authority to say so?</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p18">29. Strength of Israel - So he calls God here, to shew
the reason why God neither will nor can lie; because lying proceeds from
the sense of a man's weakness, who cannot many times accomplish his
design without lying and dissimulation; therefore many princes have used
it for this very reason. But God needs no such artifices; he can do
whatsoever he pleaseth by his absolute power. Repent - That is, nor
change his counsel; which also is an effect of weakness and
imperfection, either of wisdom or power. So that this word is not here
used in the sense it commonly is when applied to God, as in <scripRef passage="Jer. xi. 1-23" id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p18.1" parsed="|Jer|11|1|11|23" osisRef="Bible:Jer.11.1-Jer.11.23">Jer. xi, 1-23</scripRef>, and elsewhere.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p19">31. Turned - First, that the people might not upon
pretense of this sentence of rejection, withdraw their obedience to
their sovereign; whereby they would both have sinned against God, and
have been as sheep without a shepherd. Secondly, that he might rectify
Saul's error, and execute God's judgment upon Agag.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p20">33. As, &amp;c. - Whereby it appears, that he was a
tyrant, and guilty of many bloody actions. And this seems to be added
for the fuller vindication of God's justice, and to shew, that although
God did at this time revenge a crime committed by this man's ancestors
400 years ago, yet he did not punish an innocent son for his father's
crimes, but one that persisted in the same evil courses. Hewed - This he
did by divine instinct, and in pursuance of God's express command, which
being sinfully neglected by Saul, is now executed by Samuel. But these
are no precedents for private persons to take the sword of justice into
their hands. For we must live by the laws of God, and not by
extraordinary examples.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvi.ii-p21">35. To see Saul - That is, to visit him, in token of
respect or friendship: or, to seek counsel from God for him. Otherwise
he did see him chap. xix, 24. Though indeed it was not Samuel that came
thither with design to see Saul, but Saul went thither to see Samuel,
and that accidentally.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="59.55%" prev="ii.x.xvi.ii" next="ii.x.xvii.i" id="ii.x.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XVI" id="ii.x.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="59.55%" prev="ii.x.xvii" next="ii.x.xvii.ii" id="ii.x.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.x.xvii.i-p1">Samuel is appointed to anoint one of the sons of Jesse
king, ver. 1-5. The elder sons are passed by, and David anointed, ver.
6- 13. Saul growing melancholy is eased by David's music, ver. 14-
23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="59.55%" prev="ii.x.xvii.i" next="ii.x.xviii" id="ii.x.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p1">1. Mourn - And pray for his restitution, which the
following words imply he did. Oil - Which was used in the inauguration
of kings. But here it is used in the designation of a king; for David
was not actually made king by it, but still remained a subject. And the
reason of this anticipation was the comfort of Samuel, and other good
men, against their fears in case of Saul's death, and the assurance of
David's title, which otherwise would have been doubtful. I have provided
- This phrase is very emphatical, and implies the difference between
this and the former king. Saul was a king of the people's providing, he
was the product of their sinful desires: but this is a king of my own
providing, to fulfil all my will, and to serve my glory.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p2">4. Trembled - Because it was strange and unexpected to
them, this being but an obscure town, and remote from Samuel, and
therefore they justly thought there was some extraordinary reason for
it. Peaceable - The Hebrew phrase, comest thou in peace, is as much as
to say (in our phrase) is all well?</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p3">5. He sanctified - It seems evident that there was
something peculiar in Jesse's invitation. For first, both he and his
sons were invited, whereas the others were only invited for their own
persons. Secondly, the different phrase here used, that he sanctified
these, when he only bade the other sanctify themselves; argues a
singular care of Samuel in their sanctification. Which makes it
probable, that the rest were only to join with them in the act of
sacrificing; but these, and only these, were invited to feast upon the
remainders of the sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p4">6. Before him - That is, in this place where God is now
present. For it is observable, that not only the sacrifice is said to be
offered, but even the feast upon the remainders of it is said, to be
eaten before the Lord, <scripRef passage="Deut. xii. 7" id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Deut|12|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.12.7">Deut. xii, 7</scripRef>, that is, before or near his altar, where God was present in
a special manner. This I take to be the person I am sent to anoint:
wherein yet be was mistaken, as other prophets sometimes were, when they
hastily spake their own thoughts, before they had consulted God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p5">10. Seven - There are but seven named, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ii. 13-15" id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|1Chr|2|13|2|15" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.2.13-1Chr.2.15">1 Chron. ii, 13-15</scripRef>, because one of them was either born of a concubine: or,
died immediately after this time.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p6">11. Keepeth sheep - And consequently is the most unfit of
all my sons for that high employment. Either therefore he did not
understand David's wisdom and valour, or he judged him unfit, by reason
of his mean education. And God so ordered it by his providence, that
David's choice might plainly appear to be God's work, and not Samuel's,
or Jesse's. David signifies beloved: a fit name for so eminent a type of
the Beloved Son. It is supposed, David was now about twenty years old.
If so, his troubles by Saul lasted near ten years: for he was thirty
years old when Saul died. Samuel having done this went to Ramah. He
retired to die in peace, since his eyes had seen the salvation, even the
scepter brought into the tribe of Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p7">13. Anointed him - David's brethren saw David's unction,
yet did not understand, that he was anointed to the kingdom; but were
only told by Samuel, that he was anointed to some great service, which
hereafter they should know. Thus Jesse only, and David, understood the
whole business, and his brethren were able to attest to that act of
Samuel's anointing him, which, with other collateral evidences, was
abundantly sufficient to prove David's right to the kingdom, if need
should be. The spirit,&amp;c., - That is, he was immediately endowed
with extraordinary gifts of God's Spirit, as strength, and courage, and
wisdom, and other excellent qualities which fitted him for, and put him
upon noble attempts.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p8">14. Departed - God took away that prudence, and courage,
and alacrity, and other gifts wherewith be had qualified him for his
public employment. From the Lord - That is, by God's permission, who
delivered him up to be buffeted of Satan. Troubled - Stirred up in him
unruly and tormenting passions; as envy, rage, fear, or despair. He grew
fretful, and peevish, and discontented, timorous and suspicious,
frequently starting and trembling.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p9">16. Be well - And the success confirms their opinion. For
although music cannot directly have an influence upon an evil spirit to
drive him away; yet, because the devil, as it seems, had not possession
of him, but only made use of the passions of his mind, and humours of
his body to molest him: and because it is manifest, that music hath a
mighty power to qualify and sweeten these, and to make a man sedate and
chearful; it is not strange, if the devil had not that power over him
when his mind was more composed, which he had when it was disordered; as
the devil had less power over lunaticks in the decrease, than in the
increase of the moon: <scripRef passage="Matt. xvii. 15, 18" id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|17|15|0|0;|Matt|17|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.17.15 Bible:Matt.17.18">Matt. xvii, 15, 18</scripRef>. And seeing music prepared the Lord's prophets for the
entertainment of the good Spirit, as <scripRef passage="2 Kings iii. 15" id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p9.2" parsed="|2Kgs|3|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.3.15">2
Kings iii, 15</scripRef>. Why might it not dispose Saul to the resistance of the evil
spirit? And why might not the chearing of his heart, in some measure
strengthen him against those temptations of the devil, which were fed by
his melancholy humour? And by this means, David without any contrivance
of him or his friends, is brought to court, soon after he was anointed
to the kingdom. Those whom God designs for any service, his providence
will concur with his grace, to prepare and qualify them for it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p10">18. Prudent - Wonder not, that David was so suddenly
advanced, from a poor shepherd, to so great a reputation; for these were
the effects of that Spirit of the Lord which he received when he was
anointed. The Lord, &amp;c. - That is, directs and prospers all his
undertakings.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p11">20. Sent him - This present, though in our times it would
seem contemptible, yet was very agreeable to the usage of those times,
and to the condition of Jesse, which was but mean in the world. And it
seems to have been the custom of those times, (as it is yet in the
eastern countries) when they made their appearance before princes, or
great persons, to bring a present.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p12">21. Stood before him - That is, waited upon him. And he
loved him greatly - So there was something good in Saul still: he had
not lost all, tho' he had lost the kingdom. armour-bearer - He had that
place conferred upon him, though we do not read that he ever exercised
it; for it seems he was gone back to his father upon some occasion not
related; and had abode with him some considerable time before the war
described, chap. xvii, 1-53, happened.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xvii.ii-p13">23. Departed - Namely, for a season. And the reason of
this success, may be, partly natural, and partly, supernatural,
respecting David; whom God designed by this means to bring into favour
with the king, and so to smooth the way for his advancement.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="59.67%" prev="ii.x.xvii.ii" next="ii.x.xviii.i" id="ii.x.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XVII" id="ii.x.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="59.67%" prev="ii.x.xviii" next="ii.x.xviii.ii" id="ii.x.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.x.xviii.i-p1">Goliath challenges the armies of Israel, ver. 1-11. David
coming into the camp, hears his challenge, ver. 12-27. Eliab chides
David, whose words are related to Saul, ver. 28-31. David undertakes to
fight Goliath, ver. 32-37. He rejects Saul's armour, and goes with his
sling, ver. 38-40. He attacks and slays Goliath, ver. 41-51. The
Israelites pursue the Philistines, ver. 52-53. David returns: the notice
taken of him by Saul, ver. 54-58.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="59.68%" prev="ii.x.xviii.i" next="ii.x.xix" id="ii.x.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p1">1. Gathered, &amp;c. - Probably they had heard, that
Samuel had forsaken Saul, and that Saul himself was unfit for business.
The enemies of the church are watchful to take all advantages, and they
never have greater advantage, than when her protectors have provoked
God's Spirit and prophets to leave them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p2">4. Six cubits - At least, nine feet, nine inches high.
And this is not strange; for besides the giants mentioned in Scripture,
Herodotus, Diodourus Siculus, and Pliny, make mention of persons seven
cubits high.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p3">5. Coat of mail - Made of brass plates laid over one
another, like the scales of a fish. The weight, &amp;c. - The common
shekel contained a fourth part of an ounce; and so five thousand shekels
made one thousand two hundred and fifty ounces, or seventy- eight
pounds: which weight is not unsuitable to a man of such vast strength as
his height speaks him to be.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p4">6. Greaves - Boots.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p5">7. Beam - On which the weavers fasten their web. It was
like this for thickness. And though the whole weight of Goliath's armour
may seem prodigious; yet it is not so much by far as one Athanatus did
manage: of whom Pliny relates, That he saw him come into the theatre
with arms weighing twelve thousand ounces. A shield - Probably for
state: for he that was clad in brass, little needed a shield.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p6">8. Come down - That the battle may be decided by us two
alone.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p7">11. Afraid - This may seem strange, considering the
glorious promises, and their late experience of divine assistance. And
where was Jonathan, who in the last war had so bravely engaged an whole
army of the Philistines? Doubtless he did not feel himself so stirred up
of God as he did at that time. As the best, so the bravest of men, are
no more than what God makes them. Jonathan must sit still now, because
this honour is reserved for David.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p8">12. Old man - Therefore he went not himself to the
camp.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p9">15. Went - From Saul's court: where having relieved Saul,
he was permitted to go to his father's house, to be sent for again upon
occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p10">18. Pledge - That is, bring me some token of their
welfare.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p11">19. Fighting - That is, in a posture and readiness to
fight with them; as it is explained, ver. 20, 21.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p12">20. Went, &amp;c. - Jesse little thought of sending his
son to the camp, just at that critical juncture. But the wise God orders
the time and all the circumstances of affairs, so as to serve the
designs of his own glory.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p13">24. Fled - One Philistine could never have thus put ten
thousand Israelites to flight, unless their rock, being forsaken by
them, had justly sold them and shut them up.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p14">25. Free - Free from all those tributes and charges which
either the court or the camp required.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p15">28. Naughtiness - Thy false-confidence, and vain gloried
curiosity. See the folly and wickedness of envy! How groundless its
jealousies are, how unjust its censures, how unfair it representations?
God preserve us from such a spirit!</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p16">29. A cause - Of my thus speaking? Is this giant
invincible? Is our God unable to oppose him, and subdue him? However
David is not deterred from his undertaking, by the hard words of Eliab.
They that undertake public services must not think it strange, if they
be opposed by those from whom they had reason to expect assistance, but
must humbly go on with their work, in the face, not only of their
enemies threats, but of their friends slights, suspicions, and
censures.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p17">30. He tarried - For being secretly moved by God's spirit
to undertake the combat. He speaks with divers persons about it, that it
might come to the king's ear.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p18">32. Let no man's heart, &amp;c. - It would have reflected
upon his prince to say, Let not thy heart fail: therefore he speaks in
general terms, Let no man's heart fail. A little shepherd, come but this
morning from keeping sheep, has more courage than all the mighty men of
Israel! Thus doth God often do great things for his people by the weak
things of the world.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p19">33. A youth - Not above 20 years old; and a novice, a raw
and unexperienced soldier.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p20">37. The Lord, &amp;c. - The lion and the bear were only
enemies to me and my sheep, and it was in defense of them I attacked
them. But this Philistine is an enemy to my God and his people, and it
is for their honour that I attack him.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p21">38. armour - With armour taken out of his armoury. He
seems to speak of some military vestments which were then used in war,
and were contrived for defense; such as buff-coats are now.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p22">39. Proved them - I have no skill or experience in the
managements of this kind of arms.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p23">40. Staff - His shepherd's staff. These arms in
themselves were contemptible, yet chosen by David; because he had no
skill to use other arms; because he had inward assurance of the victory,
even by these weapons; and because such a conquest would be more
honourable to God, and most shameful, and discouraging to the
Philistines.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p24">41. Drew near - Probably a signal was made, that his
challenge was accepted.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p25">42. Fair - Not having so much as the countenance of a
martial person.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p26">43. Dog - Dost thou think to beat me as easily as thou
wouldst thy dog?</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p27">46. A God - Hebrew. that God, the only true God, is for
Israel; or on Israel's side, and against you. Or, that Israel hath a
God, a God indeed, one who is able to help them; and not such an
impotent idol as you serve.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p28">47. Saveth - That is, that he can save without these
arms, and with the most contemptible weapons. The battle - That is, the
events of war are wholly in his power. He will - David speaks thus
confidently, because he was assured of it by a particular
inspiration.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p29">48. Drew nigh - Like a stalking mountain. Ran - So far
was he from fear!</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p30">49. Forehead - Probably the proud giant had lift up that
part of his helmet which covered his fore-head; in contempt of David and
his weapons, and by the singular direction of providence.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p31">51. David took - Hence it appears, that David was not a
little man, as many fancy; but a man of considerable bulk and strength,
because he was able to manage a giant's sword. The stone threw him down
to the earth, and bereaved him of sense and motion; but there remained
some life in him, which the sword took away, and so compleated the work.
God is greatly glorified, when his proud enemies are cut off with their
own sword.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xviii.ii-p32">55. Whose son - David had been some considerable time
dismissed from Saul's court, and was returned home. And therefore it is
not strange, if Saul for the present had forgot David. Besides the
distemper of Saul's mind might make him forgetful; and that David might
be now much changed, both in his countenance and in his habit. I cannot
tell - Abner's employment was generally in the camp, when David was at
the court; and when Abner was there, he took little notice of a person
so much inferior to him as David was.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="59.80%" prev="ii.x.xviii.ii" next="ii.x.xix.i" id="ii.x.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XVIII" id="ii.x.xix-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="59.80%" prev="ii.x.xix" next="ii.x.xix.ii" id="ii.x.xix.i">

<p id="ii.x.xix.i-p1">David becomes the friend of Jonathan, the constant
attendant of Saul, and the favourite of all the people, ver. 1-5. Saul's
envy raised, ver. 6-9. He seeks to kill David, ver. 10-11 Is afraid of
him, ver. 12-16. Promises to give him his elder daughter, and gives him
the younger, hoping to destroy him thereby, but in vain, ver. a 7-27. He
is more feared by Saul and esteemed by the people, ver. 28-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="59.80%" prev="ii.x.xix.i" next="ii.x.xx" id="ii.x.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p1">1. Loved him - For his excellent virtues and endowments,
which shone forth both in his speeches and actions; for the service he
had done to God and to his people; and for the similitude of their age
and qualities.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p2">2. Took him, &amp;c. - By which it appears, that before
this David had not his constant residence at court.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p3">5. Went - Upon military expeditions, of which that word
is often used.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p4">10. The evil spirit, &amp;c. - His fits of frenzy
returned upon him. The very next day after he conceived envy at David,
the evil spirit was permitted by God to seize him again. Such is the
fruit of envy and uncharitableness. Prophesied - That is, he used
uncouth gestures, and signs, as the prophets often did.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p5">11. And Saul cast the javelin - Being now quite under the
power of that evil spirit. Twice - Once now, and another time upon a
like occasion, chap. xix, 10.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p6">12. Afraid - Lest as he had gained the favour of God and
of all the people, he should also take away his kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p7">13. Removed him from him - From his presence and court;
which he did, because he feared lest David should find an opportunity to
kill him, as he had designed to kill David; because his presence now
made him more sad than ever his musick made him chearful: and
principally, that hereby he might expose him to the greatest
hazards.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p8">18. What is my life - How little is my life worth, that
by the exposing of that to some hazard, I should purchase a king's
daughter! In these expressions David sheweth not only his humility, but
also his wisdom, in discovering so deep a sense of his own meanness,
that Saul might see how far he was from aspiring at the kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p9">19. Adriel - The son of Bar-zillai, as he is called, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xxi. 8" id="ii.x.xix.ii-p9.1" parsed="|2Sam|21|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.21.8">2 Sam. xxi, 8</scripRef>. This was an act of great injustice; and accordingly this
marriage was accursed by God, and the children begotten in it, were, by
God's appointment cut off, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xxi. 8, 9" id="ii.x.xix.ii-p9.2" parsed="|2Sam|21|8|21|9" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.21.8-2Sam.21.9">2 Sam. xxi, 8, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p10">26. The days - That is, the time allowed by Saul to David
for the execution of this exploit.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p11">27. Two hundred - He doubled the number required; to
oblige Saul the more to the performance of his promise; and to shew his
great respect and affection to Saul's daughter.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xix.ii-p12">30. Went forth - To war against the Israelites, being
provoked by their former losses, and especially by that act of
David's.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="59.84%" prev="ii.x.xix.ii" next="ii.x.xx.i" id="ii.x.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XIX" id="ii.x.xx-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="59.84%" prev="ii.x.xx" next="ii.x.xx.ii" id="ii.x.xx.i">

<p id="ii.x.xx.i-p1">Saul is pacified by Jonathan, ver. 1-7. Attempts again to
kill David, ver. 8-10. Is deceived by Michal, who sends David away, ver.
11-17. David flies to Ramah, and Saul prophesies, ver. 18-24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="59.85%" prev="ii.x.xx.i" next="ii.x.xxi" id="ii.x.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xx.ii-p1">4. Spake good - Which he could not do without hazard to
himself. Herein therefore he performed the duty of a true friend, and of
a valiant man.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xx.ii-p2">6. As the Lord, &amp;c. - And without all doubt, he
intended what he said, feeling a real change in himself for the present.
"God," says Mr. Henry, "inclined the heart of Saul to hearken to the
voice of Jonathan."</p>

<p id="ii.x.xx.ii-p3">8. And David, &amp;c. - So David continues his good
service, tho' it was ill requited. They who are ill paid for doing good,
yet must not be weary of well doing, remembering how bountiful a
benefactor God is, even to the evil and unthankful.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xx.ii-p4">9. The evil spirit - David's successes against the
Philistines revived his envy, and the devil watched the opportunity, as
he had done before.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xx.ii-p5">13. Goats hair - Or, put great goats hair upon his
bolster; upon the head and face of the image, which lay upon his
bolster, that it might have some kind of resemblance of David's head and
hair, at least in a sick man's bed, where there useth to be but a
glimmering light. Covered it - Upon pretense of his being sick, and
needing some such covering.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xx.ii-p6">18. To Samuel - Both for comfort and direction in his
distress; and for safety, supposing that Saul would be ashamed to
execute his bloody designs in the presence of so venerable a person as
Samuel.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xx.ii-p7">20. Over them - To instruct and direct them in those holy
exercises. For though they prophesied by Divine inspiration, yet they
were both to prepare themselves for it before hand, and to make good
improvement of it afterwards, in both which they needed Samuel's counsel
and assistance. And whereas some might falsely pretend to those
raptures; or the devil might transform himself into an angel of light,
Samuel's presence and judgment was necessary to prevent and to detect
such impostures. Besides, Samuel would by his present conjunction with
them in those holy exercises, encourage them, and stir up others to the
coveting of those gifts, and to the performance of such religious
duties. Prophesied - Being inspired by God as Balaam was; that being
wrapt up into such an extasy, their minds might be wholly taken off from
their design of seizing David.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xx.ii-p8">23. The spirit - It came upon him in the way; whereas it
came not upon his messengers 'till they came to the place. Hereby God
would convince Saul of the vanity of his designs against David, and that
in them he fought against God himself.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xx.ii-p9">24. Lay down - Hebrew. fell, down upon the earth; for his
mind being in an extasy, he had not the use of his senses. God so
ordering it, that David might have an opportunity to escape. Naked -
That is, stript of his upper garments, as the word naked is often used;
and it is here repeated to signify how long he lay in that posture. Day
and night - So God kept him as it were in chains, 'till David was got
out of his reach. Is Saul - The same proverb which was used before, is
here revived, as an evidence of God's wonderful care over David; he made
Saul in some sort a prophet, that he mightst make David a king.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="59.90%" prev="ii.x.xx.ii" next="ii.x.xxi.i" id="ii.x.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XX" id="ii.x.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="59.90%" prev="ii.x.xxi" next="ii.x.xxi.ii" id="ii.x.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxi.i-p1">David complains to Jonathan; and desires his help, ver.
1-5. Jonathan promises to give him intelligence, and confirms his
friendship, ver. 9-23. He finds his father implacable, ver. 24-34. He
gives David notice of it, in the manner they had agreed on, ver.
35-42.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="59.91%" prev="ii.x.xxi.i" next="ii.x.xxii" id="ii.x.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p1">2. Is it not so - For Jonathan gave credit to his
father's oath, chap. xix, 6.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p2">3. David swear - The matter being of great moment, and
Jonathan doubting the truth of it, he confirms his word with an oath,
which follows in the end of the verse. Only he interposeth a reason why
Saul concealed it from Jonathan.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p3">5. To the third day - That is, unto the next day, but one
after the new moon. His meaning is not, that he would hide himself in
any certain place all the three days, but that he would secure himself
either at Bethlehem with his friends, or in any other place 'till the
third day.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p4">6. Asked me - Who being the king's son and deputy, used
to give license to military men to depart for a season upon just
occasions.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p5">8. Deal kindly - In giving me timely notice, and a true
account of Saul's disposition and intention towards me. A covenant of
the Lord - That is, a solemn covenant, not lightly undertaken, but
seriously entered into, in the name and fear of God, and in his
presence, calling him to be the witness of our sincerity therein, and
the avenger of perfidiousness in him that breaks it. Slay me - I am
contented thou shouldst kill me. For why - Why shouldst thou betray me
to thy father, by concealing his evil intentions from me?</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p6">12. O Lord God - Do thou hear and judge between us. It is
an abrupt speech which is usual in great passions.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p7">14. Kindness as the Lord - That kindness to which thou
hast engaged thyself, in the covenant sworn between thee and me in God's
presence. I die not - That thou do not kill me or mine, as princes of
another line use to kill the nearest relations of the former line, from
whom the kingdom was translated to them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p8">16. A covenant - The covenant which before was personal,
he now extends to the whole house of David, expecting a reciprocal
enlargement of it on David's side, which doubtless he obtained. Enemies
- If either I or any of my house shall break this covenant, and shall
prove enemies to David or to his house, let the Lord, the witness of
this covenant, severely punish the violators of it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p9">17. Swear again - Hebrew. and Jonathan added or proceeded
to make David swear; that is, having himself sworn to David or adjured
David, in the foregoing verse, he here requires David's oath to him, by
way of restipulation or confirmation. Loved him - Because he had a true
friendship for David, he desired that the covenant might be inviolably
observed through all their generations.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p10">19. Was in hand - When this same business which now they
were treating about, was in agitation formerly; namely, to discover
Saul's mind and purpose towards him, chap. xix, 2, 3. Ezel - By that
stone which directs travelers in the way; namely, in some cave, or
convenient place, which was near it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p11">21. I will send - I will send him out before I shoot, to
find out, and take up the arrows which I shall shoot. And I shall shoot
them either short of him, or beyond him, as I shall see occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p12">23. Between - As a witness and a judge between us and our
families forever, if on either side this league of friendship be
violated.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p13">24. Hid himself - Namely, at the time appointed: for it
seems probable, that he went first to Bethlehem, and thence returned to
the field, when the occasion required.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p14">25. Arose - He rose from his seat where he was sat next
the king, and stood at Abner's coming, to do honour to him, who was his
father's cousin, and the general of the army.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p15">26. Something - Some accident which has rendered him
unclean, and so unfit to partake of this feast, which consisted in part
of the remainders of the peace-offerings, according to the law, <scripRef passage="Levit vii. 20" id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Lev|7|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.7.20">Levit vii,
20</scripRef>. Unfit also to come into any company, much more, into the
king's company, lest he should pollute them also.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p16">27. Son of Jesse - So he calls him in scorn, to note the
meanness of his original; and as not deigning to call him by his proper
name. To day - For the uncleanness which came by some chance, usually
lasted but for one day.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p17">30. Thy confusion - Men will conclude that thou hast no
royal blood in thy veins, that canst so tamely give up thy crown to so
contemptible a person.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p18">33. To smite him - Saul seemed to be in great care, that
Jonathan should be established in his kingdom: and now he himself aims
at his life! What fools, what worse than savage beasts does anger
make.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p19">37. To - That is, near the place. For the words following
shew, that he was not yet come thither.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxi.ii-p20">40. Artillery - His bow, and arrows, and quiver.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="59.98%" prev="ii.x.xxi.ii" next="ii.x.xxii.i" id="ii.x.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXI" id="ii.x.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="59.98%" prev="ii.x.xxii" next="ii.x.xxii.ii" id="ii.x.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxii.i-p1">David coming to Nob, takes the shew-bread, and Goliath's
sword, ver. 1-9. Goes to Achish, and feigns himself mad, ver. 10- 13. Is
dismissed by Achish, ver. 14, 15.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="59.99%" prev="ii.x.xxii.i" next="ii.x.xxiii" id="ii.x.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p1">1. Nob - A city of priests, where the tabernacle now was.
Hither David resorted, for a supply of his necessities, which he
supposed he might receive here, without danger of being betrayed into
Saul's hands: and principally, that in this great distress, he might
receive comfort and counsel from the Lord. Ahimelech - The chief priest,
brother to that Ahiah, chap. xiv, 3, and he being now dead, his
successor in the priesthood, for they were both sons of Ahitub. Was
afraid - Suspecting some extraordinary cause of his coming in such a
manner. Alone - For though David had some servants as is manifest from
ver. 4, 5, whom Jonathan probably had sent to a place appointed, yet
they were left at another place: as David himself affirmeth, ver. 2. And
David was now alone, as also he was when he fled to Achish. He who had
been suddenly advanced to the highest honour, is as soon reduced to the
desolate conditions of an exile. Such changes are there in this world,
and so uncertain are its smiles.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p2">2. The king, &amp;c. - This seems to be a plain lie
extorted from him, by fear. But it was pernicious to all the priests
there. Whence David afterwards declares his repentance for this sin of
lying, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xix, 29. To such a place - To a certain place which it not
convenient now to mention; because the whole business requires
concealment.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p3">4. There is, &amp;c. - Here in the tabernacle: though
doubtless he had other provisions is his house; but David was in great
haste, and in fear of Doeg whom he saw, and knew and therefore would not
stay 'till any thing could be fetched thence. There was a double
impediment to the giving this bread to them;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p4">1. Its sacredness in itself; which the
priest implies, and David answers ver. 5, and the priest was satisfied
therein by David's great necessities.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p5">2. The abstinence from all women, which he
supposed should be in those that use it; concerning which he now
inquires. And though he mentions this only concerning David's young men,
and out of reverence forbears to name him; yet he is also included in
the number, as David's answer shews.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p6">5. Three days - As long as the law required, <scripRef passage="Exod. xix. 15" id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Exod|19|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.19.15">Exod. xix, 15</scripRef>. And so long David, and his men hid, it seems, hid
themselves for fear of Saul, whereby they were kept both from women: and
from food convenient for them. Vessels - That is, Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p7">1. Their garments, or other utensils for
their journey. Or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p8">2. their bodies. The bread - Hebrew. and
this bread; is in a manner common: that is, considering the time, and
our necessity, this maybe used in a manner, like common bread. For
though for a season while it is to stand before the Lord, it be so holy,
that the priest himself might not eat it; yet afterwards it is eaten by
the priest, and his whole family, and so it may be by us, in our
circumstances. Tho' it were - But newly put into the vessel, it must
give place to the great law of necessity, and charity; because God will
have mercy preferred before sacrifice.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p9">7. Detained - Not by force but by his choice; he fixed
his abode there for that day; either because it was the sabbath-day; on
which he might not proceed in his journey, or for the discharge of some
vow. Before the Lord - That is, at the tabernacle. An Edomite - By
birth, but he was proselyted to the Jewish religion.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p10">9. Ephod - That is, behind that holy place allotted for
the keeping of the sacred, or priestly garments; all which are here
comprehended under the ephod; which, as the chief is put for all the
rest. Here it was laid up as a sacred monument of God's power and
goodness. None like it - Because it not only served him for his use, for
he was a strong and tall man, and one that could wield that sword, but
was also a pledge of God's favour to him. Whenever be looked upon it, it
would be a support to his faith, by reminding him of what God had
already done.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p11">10. To Achish - A strange action; but it must be
considered, that Saul's rage was so great, his power also, and diligence
in hunting after him that he despaired of escaping any other way: and a
desperate disease, produceth a desperate remedy. The king elect is here
an exile: anointed to the crown, and yet forced to run his country. So
do God's providences sometimes run counter to his promises, for the
trial of our faith, and the glorifying his name in accomplishing his
counsels, notwithstanding the difficulties that lie in the way.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p12">11. King of the land - Of Canaan. They call him king,
either more generally for the governor, the most eminent captain and
commander, or, as the king elect, the person designed to be king: for,
by this time, the fame of Saul's rejection, and David's destination to
the kingdom, was got abroad among the Israelites, and from them,
probably to the Philistines. Did they not sing, &amp;c. - And therefore
consider what to do; and now our great enemy is in thy hand, be sure
thou never let him go alive.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p13">12. Was afraid - Lest either their revenge or policy
should prompt them to kill him. Perhaps he was the more apprehensive,
because he wore Goliath's sword, which was probably well known at Gath.
He now learned by experience what he afterward taught us, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xviii,
9. It is better to trust in the Lord, than to put any confidence in
princes.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxii.ii-p14">15. Mad men - It is highly probable, Achish was aware,
that this madness was counterfeit. But being desirous to preserve David,
he speaks as if he thought it real.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="60.08%" prev="ii.x.xxii.ii" next="ii.x.xxiii.i" id="ii.x.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXII" id="ii.x.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="60.08%" prev="ii.x.xxiii" next="ii.x.xxiii.ii" id="ii.x.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.i-p1">David escapes to the cave of Adullam, where many resort
to him, ver. 1, 2. Lodges his parents with the king of Moab, ver. 3, 4.
Comes to the forest of Hareth, ver. 5. Saul complains of his servants as
unfaithful to him, ver. 6-8. On the information of Doeg, he orders the
priests of Nob to be slain, and their city destroyed, ver. 9-19. David
is informed of this by Abiathar, ver. 20-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXII" progress="60.09%" prev="ii.x.xxiii.i" next="ii.x.xxiv" id="ii.x.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p1">2. Debt - Probably poor debtors, whom the creditors were
obliged to spare, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxii. 25" id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Exod|22|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.22.25">Exod. xxii, 25</scripRef>. And though their persons were with David, yet their lands
and goods were liable to their creditors. Captain over them - He did not
maintain any injustice or wickedness, which some of them possibly might
be guilty of; but on the contrary, he instructed and obliged them to the
practice of all justice and honesty.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p2">3. 'Till I know, &amp;c. - He expresses his hopes very
modestly, as one that had entirely cast himself upon God, and committed
his way to him, trusting not in his own arts or arms, but in the wisdom,
power and goodness of God.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p3">4. Hold - In holds; the singular number being put for the
plural; as is frequent; that is, as long as David was forced to go from
place to place, and from hold to hold, to secure himself: for it
concerned David to secure his father, and he did doubtless secure him
for all that time; and not only while he was in the hold of Mizpeh, or
of Adullam, which was but a little while.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p4">5. Abide not - Do not shut up thyself here. Judah - Go
and shew thyself in the land of Judah, that thou mayest publicly put in
thy claim to the kingdom after Saul's death; and that thy friends may be
invited and encouraged to appear on thy behalf. Hereby also God would
exercise David's faith, and wisdom, and courage; and so prepare him for
the kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p5">6. Spear - It seems, as an ensign of majesty, for in old
times kings carried a spear instead of a scepter.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p6">7. Ye Benjamites - You that are of my own tribe and
kindred, from whom David designs to translate the kingdom to another
tribe. Will he distribute profits and preferments among you Benjamites,
as I have done? Will he not rather prefer those of his own tribe before
you?</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p7">8. That all, &amp;c. - See the nature of jealousy, and
its arts of wheedling to extort discoveries of things that are not.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p8">10. He inquired - David chargeth him with the sin of
lying, <scripRef passage="Psalm lii. 3" id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|52|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.52.3">Psalm
lii, 3</scripRef>, and it is not improbable, that he told many lies not here
expressed; and withal, he was guilty of concealing part of the truth,
which in this case he was obliged to declare for Ahimelech's just
defense, namely, the artifice whereby David circumvented Ahimelech:
making him believe, that he was then going upon the king's business, so
that the service he did to David, was designed in honour to Saul.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p9">11. The priests - Of the house of Eli, which God had
threatened to cut off, chap. ii, 31.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p10">14. And said - He doth not determine the difference
between Saul and David; nor affirm what David now was: but only declared
what David formerly had been, and what he was still, for anything he
knew to the contrary.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p11">15. Knew nothing of all this - Of any design against
thee.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p12">18. The Edomite - This is noted to wipe off the stain of
this butchery from the Israelitish nation, and to shew, why he was so
ready to do it, because he was one of that nation which had an
implacable hatred against all Israelites, and against the priests of the
Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p13">19. Both men, &amp;c. - In all the life of Saul, there is
no wickedness to be compared to this. He appears now to be wholly under
the power of that evil spirit which had long tormented him. And this
destruction could not but go to the heart of every pious Israelite, and
make them wish a thousand times, they had been content with the
government of Samuel.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiii.ii-p14">20. Abiathar - Who by his father's death was now
high-priest.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="60.15%" prev="ii.x.xxiii.ii" next="ii.x.xxiv.i" id="ii.x.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXIII" id="ii.x.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxiv-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="60.15%" prev="ii.x.xxiv" next="ii.x.xxiv.ii" id="ii.x.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.i-p1">David saves Keilah from the Philistines, ver. 1-6. His
danger there, and deliverance from it, ver. 7-13. He remains in the
wilderness of Ziph, and is visited by Jonathan, ver. 14-18. Saul pursues
him, ver. 19-25. His narrow escape, ver. 26-29</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="60.15%" prev="ii.x.xxiv.i" next="ii.x.xxv" id="ii.x.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p1">1. The Philistines, &amp;c. - Probably it was the
departure of God and David from Saul, that encouraged the Philistines to
make this inroad. When princes begin to persecute God's people and
ministers, let them expect nothing but vexation on all sides.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p2">4. Inquired again - Not for his own, but for his soldiers
satisfaction.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p3">6. Ephod - With the Ephod, the high-priest's Ephod,
wherein were the Urim and the Thummim, which when Ahimelech and the rest
of the priests went to Saul, were probably left in his hand. This gave
him the opportunity both of escaping, whilst Doeg the butcher was
killing his brethren, and of bringing away the Ephod, which Saul now was
justly deprived of.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p4">11. The Lord said - From this place it may appear that
God's answer by Urim and Thummim, was not by any change in the colour or
situation of the precious stones in the breast-plate of the Ephod, but
by a voice or suggestion from God to the high-priest. He will - He
purposeth to come, if thou continuest here. For still as David's
question, so God's answer, is upon supposition.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p5">16. And strengthened - He comforted and supported him
against all his fears, by minding him of God's infallible promises made
to him, and his singular providence which hitherto had and still would
be with him.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p6">17. Next to thee - Which he gathered either from David's
generosity, and friendship to him; or from some promise made to him by
David concerning it. So that the whole imports thus much; I do not look
to be king myself (as by my birth I might expect,) but that thou shalt
be king (God having so appointed) and I but in a secondary place
inferior to thee.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p7">18. Made a covenant - They then parted, and never came
together again, that we find, in this world.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p8">19. Ziphites - Who were of David's own tribe tho' for
this their unnatural carriage to him, he calls them strangers, <scripRef passage="Psalm liv. 3" id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|54|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.54.3">Psalm liv, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p9">25. A rock - That is, into a cave which was in the rock;
where at first he might think to hide himself, but upon farther
consideration he removed from thence upon Saul's approach.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p10">27. A messenger, &amp;c. - The wisdom of God is never at
a loss for ways, and means to preserve his people.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxiv.ii-p11">28. Called, &amp;c. - That is, The rock of divisions,
because there Saul was separated, and in a manner pulled asunder from
David, who was now almost within his reach.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="60.20%" prev="ii.x.xxiv.ii" next="ii.x.xxv.i" id="ii.x.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXIV" id="ii.x.xxv-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIV" progress="60.20%" prev="ii.x.xxv" next="ii.x.xxv.ii" id="ii.x.xxv.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxv.i-p1">Saul pursues David to Engedi, ver. 1, 2. David cuts off
his skirt, ver. 3-7. He reasons with Saul, ver. 8-15. Saul owns his
fault, and returns home, ver. 16-22</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIV" progress="60.20%" prev="ii.x.xxv.i" next="ii.x.xxvi" id="ii.x.xxv.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p1">2. Rocks - Which the wild goats used to delight in and
climb over. These very rocks are exceeding steep, and full of
precipices, and dangerous to travelers, as an eye-witness hath left upon
record. And yet Saul was so transported with rage, as to venture himself
and his army here, that he might take David, who, as he thought, would
judge himself safe, and therefore be secure in such inaccessible
places.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p2">3. Went in - To sleep there: Saul being a military man,
used to sleep with his soldiers upon the ground. And it is not
improbable, that being weary with his eager and almost incessant
pursuit, first of David, then of the Philistines, and now of David
again, he both needed and desired some sleep, God also disposing him
thereto, that David might have this eminent occasion to demonstrate his
integrity to Saul, and to all Israel. Of the cave - For that there were
vast caves in those parts is affirmed, not only by Josephus, but also by
Heathen authors; Strabo writes of one which could receive four thousand
men.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p3">4. Behold, &amp;c. - Not that God had said these words,
or made any such promise; but they put this construction upon those
promises which God had made to him, of delivering him from all his
enemies, and carrying him through all difficulties to the throne. This
promise they conceived put him under an obligation of taking all
opportunities which God put into his hand for their accomplishment.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p4">10. Mine eye - The eye is said to spare, because it
affects the heart with pity, and moves a man to spare.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p5">12. Will avenge - If thou persistest in thy injuries and
cruel designs against me.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p6">13. Wickedness, &amp;c. - That is, wicked men will do
wicked actions, among which this is one, to kill their sovereign Lord
and king; and therefore if I were so wicked a person as thy courtiers
represent me, I should make no conscience of laying violent hands upon
thee.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p7">16. Thy voice - He knew his voice, though being at a
great distance from him, he could not discern his face. Wept - From the
sense of his sin against God, and his base carriage to David. He speaks
as one quite overcome with David's kindness, and as one that relents at
the sight of his own folly and ingratitude.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p8">17. More righteous than I - He ingenuously acknowledges
David's integrity, and his own iniquity.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p9">19. The Lord reward thee - Because he thought himself not
able to recompense so great a favour, he prays God to recompense it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxv.ii-p10">22. Unto the hold - Of En-gedi, ver. 1, for having had by
frequent experience of Saul's inconstancy, he would trust him no
more.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="60.24%" prev="ii.x.xxv.ii" next="ii.x.xxvi.i" id="ii.x.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXV" id="ii.x.xxvi-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.25" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxvi-p0.2">XXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXV" progress="60.24%" prev="ii.x.xxvi" next="ii.x.xxvi.ii" id="ii.x.xxvi.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.i-p1">Samuel's death, ver. 1. The character of Nabal, ver. 2,
3. David's requests to him, ver. 4-9. His churlish answer, ver. 10-13.
David's purpose to destroy him told to Abigail, ver. 13-17. She pacifies
David, ver. 18-31. His answer, ver. 32-35. The death of Nabal, ver.
36-38. David marries Abigail and Ahinoam, ver. 39- 44.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXV" progress="60.25%" prev="ii.x.xxvi.i" next="ii.x.xxvii" id="ii.x.xxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p1">1. Lamented him - Those have hard hearts, that can bury
their faithful ministers with dry eyes, and are not sensible of the loss
of them who have prayed for them, and taught them the way of the
Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p2">2. Carmel - In some part of this wilderness Israel
wandered, when they came out of Egypt. The place would bring to mind
God's care concerning them, which David might now improve for his own
encouragement.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p3">3. Abigail - That is, the joy of his father: yet he could
not promise himself much joy of her, when he married her to such an
husband: it seems, in inquiring, (no unfrequent thing) more after his
wealth, than after his wisdom. Caleb - This is added to aggravate his
crime, that he was a degenerate branch of that noble stock of Caleb, and
consequently of the tribe of Judah, as David was.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p4">4. Shear sheep - Which times were celebrated with
feasting.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p5">6. Prosperity - By this expression David both
congratulates Nabal's felicity, and tacitly minds him of the distress in
which he and his men were.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p6">7. We hurt not - This considering the licentiousness of
soldiers, and the necessities David and his men were exposed to, was no
small favour, which Nabal was bound both in justice, and gratitude, and
prudence to requite.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p7">8. A good day - That is, in a day of feasting and
rejoicing; when men are most chearful and liberal; when thou mayst
relieve us out of thy abundance without damage to thyself; when thou art
receiving the mercies of God, and therefore obliged to pity and relieve
distressed and indigent persons.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p8">17. Can not speak - But he flies into a passion.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p9">18. Abigail took, &amp;c. - This she did without his
leave, because it was a case of apparent necessity, for the preservation
of herself, and husband, and all the family from imminent ruin. And
surely, that necessity which dispenseth with God's positive commands,
might dispense with the husband's right, in this case. Bottles - Casks
or rundlets.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p10">22. Enemies of David - That is, unto David himself. But
because it might seem ominous to curse himself, therefore instead of
David, he mentions David's enemies. But is this the voice of David? Can
he speak so unadvisedly with his lips? Has he been so long in the school
of affliction, and learned no more patience therein? Lord, what is man?
And what need have we to pray, lead us not into temptation.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p11">24. And said, &amp;c. - Impute Nabal's sin to me, and if
thou pleasest, punish it in me, who here offer myself as a sacrifice to
thy just indignation. This whole speech of Abigail shews great wisdom,
by an absolute submitting to mercy, without any pretense of
justification, of what was done, (but rather with aggravation of it) she
endeavours to work upon David's generosity, to pardon it. And there is
hardly any head of argument, whence the greatest orator might argue in
this case, which she doth not manage to the best advantage.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p12">25. Nabal is his name - Nabal signifies a fool.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p13">26. As Nabal - Let them be as contemptible as Nabal is,
and will be for this odious action; let them be as unable to do thee any
hurt as he is; let them be forced to yield to thee, and implore thy
pardon, as Nabal now doth by my mouth: let the vengeance thou didst
design upon Nabal and his family fall upon their heads, who, by their
inveterate malice against thee, do more deserve it than this fool for
this miscarriage; and much more than all the rest of our family, who, as
they are none of thine enemies, so they were in way guilty of this
wicked action. And therefore spare these, and execute thy vengeance upon
more proper objects.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p14">27. Blessing - So a gift or present is called here, and
elsewhere; not only because the matter of it comes from God's blessing;
but also because it is given with a blessing, or with a good will. Unto
the young men - As being unworthy of thine acceptance or use.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p15">28. The trespass - That is, which I have taken upon
myself, and which, if it be punished, the punishment will reach to me.
Sure house - Will give the kingdom to thee, and to thy house forever,
as he hath promised thee. And therefore let God's kindness to thee, make
thee gentle and merciful to others; do not sully thy approaching glory
with the stain of innocent blood; but consider, that it is the glory of
a king, to profit by offenses: and that it will be thy loss to cut off
such as will shortly be thy subjects. The battles - For the Lord, and
for the people of the Lord against their enemies; especially, the
Philistines. And as this is thy proper work, and therein thou mayest
expect God's blessing; so it is not thy work to draw thy sword in thy
own private quarrel against any of the people of the Lord; and God will
not bless thee in it. Evil hath not, &amp;c. - Though thou hast been
charged with many crimes by Saul and others; yet thy innocency is
evident to all men: do not therefore by this cruel act, justify thine
enemies reproaches, or blemish thy great and just reputation.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p16">29. A man - Saul though no way injured. Thy soul - To
take away thy life. Bundle of life - Or, in the bundle: that is, in the
society, or congregation of the living; out of which, men are taken, and
cut off by death. The phrase is taken from the common usage of men, who
bind those things in bundles, which they are afraid to lose. The meaning
is, God will preserve thy life; and therefore it becomes not thee,
unnecessarily to take away the lives of any; especially of the people of
thy God. With the Lord - That is, in the custody of God, who by his
watchful providence, preserves this bundle, and all that are in it; and
thee in a particular manner, as being thy God in a particular way, and
special covenant. The Jews understand this. not only of the present
life, but of that which is to come, even the happiness of departed
souls, and therefore use it commonly, as an inscription on their
grave-stones. "Here we have laid the body, trusting the soul is bound up
in the bundle of life with the Lord." Sling out - God himself will cut
them off suddenly, violently, and irresistibly; and cast them far away;
both from his presence, and from thy neighbourhood, and from all
capacity of doing thee hurt.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p17">31. No grief - The mind and conscience will be free from
all the torment which such an action would cause in thee. By which, she
intimates, what a blemish this would be to his glory, what a disturbance
to his peace, if he proceeded to execute his purpose: and withal
implies, how comfortable it would be to him to remember, that he had for
conscience to God, restrained his passions. Causeless - Which she
signifies would be done if he should go on. For though Nabal had been
guilty of abominable rudeness, and ingratitude; yet he had done nothing
worthy of death, by the laws of God or of man. And whatsoever he had
done, the rest of his family were innocent. Avenged - Which is directly
contrary to God's law, <scripRef passage="Levit xix. 18" id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Lev|19|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.18">Levit xix, 18</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxii. 35" id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p17.2" parsed="|Deut|32|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.32.35">Deut. xxxii, 35</scripRef>. Then - When God shall make thee king, let me find grace in
thy sight.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p18">32. The Lord - Who by his gracious providence so disposed
matters, that thou shouldst come to me: He rightly begins at the
fountain of his deliverance; and then proceeds to the instruments.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p19">33. From coming, &amp;c. - Which I had sworn to do.
Hereby it plainly appears, that oaths whereby men bind themselves to any
sin, are null and void: and as it was a sin to make them; so it is
adding sin to sin to perform them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p20">35. Accepted - That is, shewed my acceptance of thy
person, by my grant of thy request.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p21">36. A feast - As the manner was upon those solemn
occasions. Sordid covetousness, and vain prodigality were met together
in him. Told nothing - As he was then incapable of admonition, his
reason and conscience being both asleep.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p22">37. His heart died - He fainted away through the fear and
horror of so great a mischief though it was past. As one, who having in
the night galloped over a narrow plank, laid upon a broken bridge, over
a deep river; when in the morning he came to review it, was struck dead
with the horror of the danger he had been in.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p23">38. Smote - God either inflicted some other stroke upon
him, or increased his grief and fear to such an height, as killed
him.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvi.ii-p24">39. Blessed, &amp;c. - This was another instance of human
infirmity in David. David sent - But this doubtless was not done
immediately after Nabal's death, but some time after it; though such
circumstances be commonly omitted in the sacred history; which gives
only the heads, and most important passages of things.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="60.40%" prev="ii.x.xxvi.ii" next="ii.x.xxvii.i" id="ii.x.xxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXVI" id="ii.x.xxvii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.26" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxvii-p0.2">XXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVI" progress="60.40%" prev="ii.x.xxvii" next="ii.x.xxvii.ii" id="ii.x.xxvii.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.i-p1">The Ziphites inform Saul of David, who pursues him again,
ver. 1-3. David sends out spies, and views his camp, ver. 4, 5. Comes to
him, being asleep, and takes his spear and cruse of water, ver. 6-12.
Reasons with him upon it, ver. 13-20. Saul again owns his spirit, and
promises to pursue him no more, ver. 21-25</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVI" progress="60.40%" prev="ii.x.xxvii.i" next="ii.x.xxviii" id="ii.x.xxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p1">5. The Ziphites - Probably Saul would have pursued David
no more, had not these wretches set him on.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p2">6. Zerujah - David's sister. His father is not named
either because he was now dead; or because he was an obscure person.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p3">7. Came - That is, to Saul's host. It might seem a bold
and strange attempt; but it may be considered:</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p4">1. That David had a particular assurance
that God would preserve him to the kingdom.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p5">2. That he had a special instinct from God,
to this work; and possibly God might inform him, that he had cast them
into a deep sleep, that he might have this second opportunity of
manifesting his innocency towards Saul.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p6">9. Destroy him not, &amp;c. - Though Saul be a tyrant,
yet he is our Lord and king; and I, though designed king, as yet am his
subject; and therefore cannot kill him without sin, nor will I consent
that thou shouldst do it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p7">11. Take the spear - Which will shew where we have been,
and what we could have done.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p8">13. Afar off - That his person might be out of their
reach, and yet his voice might be heard; which in a clear air, and in
the silence of the night might be heard at a great distance.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p9">14. Cried to the people - It is probable this was early
in the morning.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p10">19. The Lord - If the Lord hath by the evil spirit which
he hath sent, or by his secret providence, directed thy rage against me
for the punishment of thine, or my sins. An offering - Let us offer up a
sacrifice to God to appease his wrath against us. Driven me - From the
land which God hath given to his people for their inheritance, and where
he hath established his presence and worship. Go serve - This was the
language of their actions. For by driving him from God's land, and the
place of his worship, into foreign and idolatrous lands, they exposed
him to the peril of being either ensnared by their counsels, or
examples; or forced by their power to worship idols.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p11">20. Before the Lord - Remember, if thou dost it, God the
judge of all men seeth it, and will avenge it; though I will not avenge
myself.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p12">21. My soul, &amp;c. - This second instance of David's
tenderness wrought more upon Saul than the former. He owns himself
melted and quite overcome by David's kindness to him. My soul was
precious in thine eyes, which I thought had been odious. He acknowledges
he had done very ill to persecute him: I have acted against God's law, I
have sinned: and against my own interest, I have played the fool, in
pursuing him as an enemy, who was indeed one of my best friends. And
herein I have erred exceedingly, have wronged both thee and myself.
Nothing can be more full and ingenuous than this confession: God surely
now touched his heart. And he promises to persecute him no more: nor
does it appear that he ever attempted it.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxvii.ii-p13">25 Blessed, &amp;c. - So strong was his conviction now,
that he could not forbear blessing him, foretelling his success,
applauding David, and condemning himself, even in the hearing of his own
soldiers. And this, it seems, was their last interview. After this they
saw each other no more.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="60.46%" prev="ii.x.xxvii.ii" next="ii.x.xxviii.i" id="ii.x.xxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXVII" id="ii.x.xxviii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.27" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxviii-p0.2">XXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVII" progress="60.46%" prev="ii.x.xxviii" next="ii.x.xxviii.ii" id="ii.x.xxviii.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.i-p1">David retires to Gath, ver. 1-4. Achish gives him Ziklag,
ver. 5-7. David destroys the Canaanites, ver. 8, 9. Persuades Achish he
fought against Judah, ver. 10-12.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVII" progress="60.46%" prev="ii.x.xxviii.i" next="ii.x.xxix" id="ii.x.xxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p1">1. I shall perish - But this was certainly a very great
fault in David: for</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p2">1. This proceeded from gross distrust of God's promise
and providence; and that after such repeated demonstrations of God's
peculiar care over him.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p3">2. He forsakes the place where God had settled him, chap.
xxii, 5, and given him both assurance and experience of his protection
there.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p4">3. He voluntarily runs upon that rock, which he cursed
his enemies for throwing him upon, chap. xxvi, 19, and upon many other
snares and dangers, as the following history will shew; and withal,
deprives the people of the Lord of those succors which he might have
given them, in case of a battle. But God hereby designed to withdraw
David from the Israelites, that they might fall by the hand of the
Philistines, without any reproach or inconvenience to David.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p5">4. Sought no more for him - At their meeting Saul's heart
was deeply wounded, and he had said, "Return, my son David, Be with me
as in time past." Nor have we the least proof, that he would have sought
for him again, with any other design.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p6">5. Give me a place - A prudent desire. Hereby David
designed to preserve his people, both from the vices, which conversation
with the Philistines would have exposed them to; and from that envy, and
malice, which diversity of religion might have caused. With thee - Which
is too great an honour for me, and too burdensome to thee, and may be an
occasion of offense to thy people.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p7">6. Gave Ziklag - Not only to inhabit, but to possess it
as his own. Which he did, to lay the greater obligations upon David,
whom he knew so able to serve him. It was given to the tribe of Judah
before, <scripRef passage="Josh. xv. 31" id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Josh|15|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.15.31">Josh. xv, 31</scripRef>, but the Philistines kept the possession of it 'till this
time. And being given by them to David, it now belonged not to the tribe
of Judah; but to the king of Judah, David and his heirs forever. To this
day - This, and some such clauses seem to have been added, after the
main substance of the several books was written.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p8">8. Amalekites - The remnant of those whom Saul destroyed,
chap. xv, 3-9, who retired into remote and desert places.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p9">9. Let neither man, &amp;c. - In that part where he came:
but there were more of the Amalekites yet left in another part of that
land.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxviii.ii-p10">10. David - These and the following words are ambiguous,
and contrary to that simplicity which became David, both as a prince,
and as an eminent professor of the true religion. The fidelity of Achish
to him, and the confidence he put in him, aggravates his sin in thus
deceiving him, which David seems penitently to reflect on, when he
prays, Remove from me the way of lying.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVIII" progress="60.51%" prev="ii.x.xxviii.ii" next="ii.x.xxix.i" id="ii.x.xxix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXVIII" id="ii.x.xxix-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|28|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.28" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxix-p0.2">XXVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVIII" progress="60.51%" prev="ii.x.xxix" next="ii.x.xxix.ii" id="ii.x.xxix.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxix.i-p1">The conference between Achish and David, ver. 1-2. The
preparation of the Philistines, and the distress of Saul, ver. 3-6. He
applies to a woman which had a familiar spirit, to raise Samuel, ver.
7-11. Samuel appears, and foretells his defeat and death, ver. 12-19.
Saul faints, and is with difficulty persuaded to take any sustenance,
ver. 20-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVIII" progress="60.51%" prev="ii.x.xxix.i" next="ii.x.xxx" id="ii.x.xxix.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p1">2. Can do - He speaks ambiguously, as he did before.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p2">5. He trembled - Had he kept close to God, he needed not
fear all the armies of the Philistines.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p3">7. That hath, &amp;c. - One that converseth with the
devil, or dead men's ghosts, and by them can discover future things. See
<scripRef passage="Isaiah viii. 19" id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Isa|8|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.8.19">Isaiah
viii, 19</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p4">8. Disguised - Both because he was ashamed to be known,
or thought guilty of this practice; and because he suspected, the woman,
had she known him, would not practice her art before him.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p5">11. Samuel - Whose kindness and compassion as he had
formerly experienced, so now he expected it in his deep distress. This
practice of divination by the dead, or the souls of dead persons, was
very usual among all nations.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p6">12. Saw Samuel - The words are express, the woman saw
Samuel, instead of the spirit whom she expected to see, God ordering it
so for his own glory. She cried with a loud voice - Terrified and
astonished, and thence easily conjectured, whom she had been talking
with.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p7">13. Gods - That is, a God, and divine person, glorious,
and full of majesty and splendour, exceeding not only mortal men, but
common ghosts. She used the plural number, gods, either after the manner
of the Hebrew language, which commonly uses that word of one person: or,
after the language and custom of the heathens.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p8">14. A mantle - The usual habit of prophets, and
particularly of Samuel, chap. xv, 27. If it was not Samuel, but an other
spirit in his shape, it is not true, that Saul perceived it was Samuel.
It seems Saul did not see him, so soon as the woman, which occasioned
his asking those questions.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p9">15. Called Samuel - Happy had it been, if he had called
Samuel sooner, or rather the God of Samuel! It was now too late:
destruction was at hand and God had determined, it should not be
stayed.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p10">17. To him - To David.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p11">19. Tomorrow shalt thou and thy sons be with me: "What do
these solemn words portend? A gleam of hope when life shall end. Thou
and thy sons, tho' slain shall be Tomorrow in repose with me. Not in a
state of health or pain If Saul with Samuel doth remain; Not in a state
of damn'd despair, If loving Jonathan is there." Tho' these words may
only mean, ye shall surely die, without any reference to the state of
their souls after death. See note on "chap. xxxi, 8"</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p12">20. Fell - As if the Archers of the Philistines had
already hit him, and there was no strength in him, to bear up against
these heavy tidings: especially, as we cannot doubt, but all his past
sins were now brought to his remembrance and what authority has any man
to affirm, that he felt no contrition all this time? Altho' it did not
seem good to the holy ghost, to leave it upon record?</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p13">21. Came to Saul - From whom she departed, when she had
brought him and Samuel together, that they might more freely converse
together.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxix.ii-p14">24. Unleavened - Not having time to leaven it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIX" progress="60.56%" prev="ii.x.xxix.ii" next="ii.x.xxx.i" id="ii.x.xxx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXIX" id="ii.x.xxx-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|29|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.29" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxx-p0.2">XXIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIX" progress="60.56%" prev="ii.x.xxx" next="ii.x.xxx.ii" id="ii.x.xxx.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxx.i-p1">The princes of the Philistines object against David's
going with them to the battle, ver. 1-5. He is dismissed by Achish, ver.
6-11.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIX" progress="60.57%" prev="ii.x.xxx.i" next="ii.x.xxxi" id="ii.x.xxx.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxx.ii-p1">2. With Achish - As the life-guard of Achish. Achish
being, as it seems, the general of the army.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxx.ii-p2">3. The princes - The Lords of the other eminent cities,
who were confederate with him in this expedition. These days or years -
That is, did I say days? I might have said years. He hath now been with
me a full year and four months, chap. xxvii, 7, and he was with me some
years ago, chap. xxi, 10, and since their time hath been known to me.
And it is not improbable, but David, after his escape from thence, might
hold some correspondence with Achish, as finding him to be a man of a
more generous temper than the rest of the Philistines, and supposing
that he might have need of him for a refuge, in case Saul continued to
seek his life. Since he fell - Revolted, or left his own king to turn to
me.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxx.ii-p3">4. Make this fellow - Herein the wise and gracious
providence of God appeared, both in helping him out of these
difficulties, out of which no human wit could have extricated him, but
he must have been, an ungrateful person either to the one or the other
side, and moreover in giving him the happy opportunity of recovering his
own, and his all from the Amalekites, which had been irrecoverably lost,
if he had gone into this battle. And the kindness of God to David was
the greater, because it had been most just for God to have left David in
those distresses into which his own sinful counsel had brought him.
These men - That is, of these our soldiers, they speak according to the
rules of true policy; for by this very course, great enemies have
sometimes been reconciled together.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxx.ii-p4">8. David said &amp;c. - This was deep dissimulation and
flattery, no way to be justified. None knows, how strong a temptation
they are in to compliment and dissemble, which they are in who attend
great men.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxx.ii-p5">9. Angel of God - In whom nothing is blame-worthy. The
Heathens acknowledged good spirits, which also they worshipped as an
inferior sort of deities, who were messengers and ministers to the
supreme God; Achish had learned the title of angels, from the Israelites
his neighbours, and especially from David's conversation.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxx.ii-p6">11. Rose up early - David did not then know, how
necessary this was, for the relief of his own city. But God knew it
well, and sent him thither accordingly. On how many occasions may he
say, What I do thou knowest not now; but thou shalt know hereafter?</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXX" progress="60.61%" prev="ii.x.xxx.ii" next="ii.x.xxxi.i" id="ii.x.xxxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXX" id="ii.x.xxxi-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|30|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.30" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxxi-p0.2">XXX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXX" progress="60.61%" prev="ii.x.xxxi" next="ii.x.xxxi.ii" id="ii.x.xxxi.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.i-p1">Ziklag plundered: David and his men distressed, ver. 1-6.
Encouraged of God, he pursues them, ver. 7-10. He gains intelligence
from a straggler, ver. 11-15. Routs the enemy, and recovers all they had
taken, ver. 16-20. Makes an order for dividing the spoil, ver. 21-25.
Sends presents to his friends, ver. 26-31</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXX" progress="60.61%" prev="ii.x.xxxi.i" next="ii.x.xxxii" id="ii.x.xxxi.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p1">1. The south - Namely, the southern part of Judah, and
the adjacent parts.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p2">4. Wept - It is no disparagement to the boldest, bravest
spirits, to lament the calamities of friends or relations.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p3">6. Stoning him - As the author of their miseries, by
coming to Ziklag at first, by provoking the Amalekites to this cruelty,
and by his forwardness in marching away with Achish, and leaving their
wives and children unguarded. Encouraged himself - That is, in this that
the all-wise, and all-powerful Lord, was his God by covenant and special
promise, and fatherly affection, as he had shewed himself to be in the
whole course of his providence towards him. It is the duty of all good
men, whatever happens, to encourage themselves in the Lord their God,
assuring themselves, that he both can and will bring light out of
darkness.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p4">7. The ephod - And put it upon thyself, that thou mayst
inquire of God according to his ordinance, David was sensible of his
former error in neglecting to ask counsel of God by the ephod, when he
came to Achish, and when he went out with Achish to the Battle; and his
necessity now brings him to his duty, and his duty meets with
success.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p5">8. He answered - Before, God answered more slowly and
gradually, chap. xxiii, 11, 12, but now he answers speedily, and fully
at once, because the business required haste. So gracious is our God,
that he considers even the degree of our necessities, and accommodates
himself to them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p6">10. Four hundred - A small number for such an attempt:
but David was strong in faith, giving God the glory of his power and
faithfulness.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p7">12. Three days and nights - One whole day and part of two
others, as appears from the next verse, where he saith, three days ago I
fell sick, but in the Hebrew it is, this is the third day since I fell
sick.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p8">13. Egypt - God by his providence so ordering it, that he
was not one of that cursed race of the Amalekites, who were to be
utterly destroyed, but an Egyptian, who might be spared. Left me - In
this place and condition: which was barbarous inhumanity: for he ought,
and easily might have carried him away with the prey which they had
taken. But he paid dear for this cruelty, for this was the occasion of
the ruin of him and all their company. And God by his secret providence
ordered the matter thus for that very end. So that there is no fighting
against God, who can make the smallest accidents serviceable to the
production of the greatest effects.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p9">14. Cherethites - That is, the Philistines. Caleb - This
is added by way of explication: that part of the south of Judah which
belongs to Caleb's posterity.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p10">15. Will bring thee - For his master had told him whither
they intended to go, that he might come after them, as soon as he
could.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p11">16. Upon all the earth - Secure and careless, because
they were now come almost to the borders of their own country, and the
Philistines and Israelites both were otherwise engaged, and David, as
they believed, with them. So they had no visible cause of danger; and
yet then they were nearest to destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p12">17. Twilight - The word signifies both the morning and
evening twilight. But the latter seems here intended, partly because
their eating, and drinking, and dancing, was more proper work for the
evening, than the morning; and partly, because the evening was more
convenient for David, that the fewness of his forces might not be
discovered by the day-light. It is probable, that when he came near
them, he reposed himself, and his army, in some secret place, whereof
there were many parts, for a convenient season; and then marched on so
as to come to them at the evening time.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p13">20. Other cattle - Before those that belonged to Ziklag.
David's spoil - The soldiers, who lately were so incensed against David,
that they spake of stoning him: now upon this success magnify him, and
triumphantly celebrate his praise; and say concerning this spoil, David
purchased it by his valour and conduct, and he may dispose of it as he
pleaseth.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p14">21. Saluted them - He spoke kindly to them, and did not
blame them because they went no further with them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p15">23. My brethren -- he useth his authority to over-rule
them; but manageth it with all sweetness, tho' they were such wicked and
unreasonable men, calling them brethren; not only as of the same nation
and religion with him, but as his fellow-soldiers. What God hath freely
imparted to us, we should not unkindly and injuriously withhold from our
brethren.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p16">24. Part alike - A prudent and equitable constitution,
and therefore practiced by the Romans, as Polybius and others note. The
reason of it is manifest; because they were exposed to hazards, as well
as their brethren: and were a reserve to whom they might retreat in case
of a defeat; and they were now in actual service, and in the station in
which their general had placed them.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxi.ii-p17">26. Elders of Judah - Partly in gratitude for their
former favours to him: and partly, in policy, to engage their affections
to him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXI" progress="60.70%" prev="ii.x.xxxi.ii" next="ii.x.xxxii.i" id="ii.x.xxxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Sam. XXXI" id="ii.x.xxxii-p0.1" parsed="|1Sam|31|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.31" /> 
<h3 id="ii.x.xxxii-p0.2">XXXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXI" progress="60.70%" prev="ii.x.xxxii" next="ii.x.xxxii.ii" id="ii.x.xxxii.i">

<p id="ii.x.xxxii.i-p1">Israel overthrown, and Saul, his three sons, his armour-
bearer and all his men slain, ver. 1-6. The Israelites forsake their
cities, ver. 7. The camp plundered and the dead bodies insulted, ver.
8-10. But rescued by the men of Jabesh-Gilead, ver. 11-13.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXI" progress="60.71%" prev="ii.x.xxxii.i" next="ii.xi" id="ii.x.xxxii.ii">

<p id="ii.x.xxxii.ii-p1">2. Jonathan - David's dear friend; God so ordering it for
the farther exercise of David's faith and patience; and that David might
depend upon God alone for his crown, and receive it solely from him, and
not from Jonathan; who doubtless, had he lived, would have speedily
settled the crown upon David's head. There was also a special providence
of God, in taking away Jonathan, (who of all Saul's sons, seems to have
been the fairest for the crown) for preventing divisions, which might
have happened amongst the people concerning the successor: David's way
to the crown being by this means made the more clear. Abinadab - Called
also Ishui, chap. xiv, 49. Ishbosheth was not here, being possibly at
home for the management of affairs there.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxii.ii-p2">8. Saul and his three sons - "The scripture, as Mr. Henry
well observes, makes no mention of the souls of Saul and his sons, what
became of them after they were dead: secret things belong not to
us."</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxii.ii-p3">9. Cut off his head - As the Israelites did by Goliath,
and fastened it in the temple of Dagon, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. x. 10" id="ii.x.xxxii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|1Chr|10|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.10.10">1 Chron. x, 10</scripRef>. Idols - To give them the glory of this victory. And by this
respect shewn to their pretended deities, how do they shame those, who
give not the honour of their achievements to the living God?</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxii.ii-p4">12. Took the body, &amp;c. - This they did, not only out
of a concern, for the honour of Israel, and the crown of Israel, but out
of gratitude to Saul, for his zeal and forwardness to rescue them from
the Ammonites.</p>

<p id="ii.x.xxxii.ii-p5">13. Fasted - To testify their sorrow for the loss of
Saul, and of the people of God; and to intreat God's favour to prevent
the utter extinction of his people. But you must not understand this
word of fasting strictly, as if they eat nothing for seven whole days;
but in a more large sense, as it is used both in sacred and profane
writers; that they did eat but little, and that but mean food, and drank
only water for that time. This book began with the birth of Samuel, and
ends with the death of Saul: The comparing these together will teach us
to prefer the honour that comes from God, before all the honours of the
world.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE SECOND BOOK OF SAMUEL" progress="60.74%" prev="ii.x.xxxii.ii" next="ii.xi.i" id="ii.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2Sam" id="ii.xi-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.xi-p0.2">NOTES ON THE SECOND BOOK OF SAMUEL</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Second Samuel" progress="60.74%" prev="ii.xi" next="ii.xi.ii" id="ii.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xi.i-p1">THIS book is the history of the reign of David. It gives us
an account of his triumphs and of his troubles.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.xi.i-p2">I. His triumphs, over the house of Saul,
chap. 1-4. Over the Jebusites and Philistines, chap. 5. In the bringing
up of the ark, chap. 6, 7. Over the neighbouring nations, chap.
8-10.</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.xi.i-p3">II. His troubles; the cause of them, his sin
in the matter of Uriah, chap. 11-12. The troubles themselves, from the
sin of Amnon, chap. 13. The rebellion of Absolom, chap. 14-19. And of
Sheba, chap. 20. From the famine, chap. 21. And the pestilence, for his
numbering the people, chap. 24. His song we have, chap. 22. And his
words and worthies, chap. 23. In many instances throughout this book, he
appears as a great and a good man. Yet it must be confessed he had great
vices: So that his honour shines brighter in his psalms than in his
annals.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="60.76%" prev="ii.xi.i" next="ii.xi.ii.i" id="ii.xi.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. I" id="ii.xi.ii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="60.76%" prev="ii.xi.ii" next="ii.xi.ii.ii" id="ii.xi.ii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.ii.i-p1">David receives an account of the death of Saul and
Jonathan, ver. 1-10. He mourns over them, ver. 11, 12. Puts the man to
death, who boasted he had killed Saul, ver. 13-16. His elegy upon Saul
and Jonathan, ver. 17-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="60.76%" prev="ii.xi.ii.i" next="ii.xi.iii" id="ii.xi.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p1">1. Ziklag - Which though burnt, yet was not so consumed
by the fire, that David and his men could not lodge in it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p2">2. Third day - From David's return to Ziklag. With his
clothes rent, &amp;c. - As a mourner.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p3">18. Judah - These he more particularly teacheth, because
they were the chief, and now the royal tribe, and likely to be the great
bulwark to all Israel against the Philistines, upon whose land they
bordered; and withal, to be the most true to him, and to his interest.
The bow - That is, of their arms, expressed, under the name of the bow,
which then was one of the chief weapons; and for the dextrous use
whereof Jonathan is commended in the following song: which may be one
reason, why he now gives forth this order, that so they might strive to
imitate Jonathan in military skill, and to excel in it, as he did.
Jasher - It is more largely and particularly described in the book of
Jasher.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p4">19. Beauty - Their flower and glory. Saul and Jonathan,
and their army. High places - Hebrew. upon thy high places; that is,
those which belong to thee, O land of Israel. How - How strangely! How
suddenly! How universally!</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p5">20. Tell it not - This is not a precept, but a poetical
wish; whereby he doth not so much desire, that this might not be done,
which he knew to be impossible; as, express his great sorrow, because it
would be done, to the dishonour of God, and of his people. The daughters
- He mentions these, because it was the custom of women in those times
and places to celebrate those victories which their men obtained, with
triumphant songs and dances.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p6">21. Let there be, &amp;c. - This is no proper
imprecation; but a passionate representation of the horror which he
conceived at this publick loss; which was such, as if he thought every
person or thing which contributed to it, were fit to bear the tokens of
divine displeasure, such as this is, when the earth wants the necessary
influences of dew and rain. Fields of offerings - That is, fruitful
fields, which may produce fair and goodly fruits fit to be offered to
God. Vilely - Dishonourably: for it was a great reproach to any soldier,
to cast away or lose his shield. Cast away - By themselves, that they
might flee more swiftly as the Israelites did, and Saul with the rest.
As though, &amp;c. - As if he had been no more, than a common soldier:
he was exposed to the same kind of death and reproach as they were.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p7">22. Not back - Without effect: their arrows shot from
their bow, and their swords did seldom miss, and commonly pierced fat,
and flesh, and blood, and reached even to the heart and bowels. Returned
not, &amp;c. - But filled and glutted with blood: for the sword is
metaphorically said to have a mouth, which we translate an edge; and to
devour. And this their former successfulness is mentioned as an
aggravation of their last infelicity.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p8">23. Lovely - Amiable, and obliging in their carriage and
conversation, both towards one another, and towards their people: for,
as for Saul's fierce behaviour towards Jonathan, it was only a sudden
passion, by which his ordinary temper was not to be measured; and for
his carriage towards David, that was from that jealousy and reason of
state which usually engageth even well- natured princes, to the same
hostilities. But it is observable, that David speaks not a word here of
his piety; but only commends him for those things which were truly in
him. A fit pattern for all preachers in their funeral commendations.
Swifter, &amp;c. - Expeditious in pursuing their enemies, and executing
their designs; which is a great commendation in a prince, and in a
soldier. Stronger, &amp;c. - In regard of their bodily strength, and the
courage of their mind.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p9">24. Daughters - These he mentions; because the women then
used to make songs both of triumph, and of lamentation, and, because
they usually are most delighted with the ornaments of the body here
following. Clothed you - This he did, because he procured them so much
peace as gave them opportunity of enriching themselves: and, because he
took these things as spoils from the enemies, and clothed his own people
with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p10">25. Thine - Which were in thy country, and (had not thy
father disinherited thee by his sins) in thy dominions.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ii.ii-p11">26. Distressed - That is, for the loss of thee. For,
besides the loss of a true friend, which is inestimable; he lost him who
both could, and undoubtedly would have given him a speedy, and quiet,
and sure possession of the kingdom, whereas now, he met with long and
troublesome interruptions. Of women - That is, that love wherewith they
love their husbands, or children for their affections are usually more
ardent than mens.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="60.84%" prev="ii.xi.ii.ii" next="ii.xi.iii.i" id="ii.xi.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. II" id="ii.xi.iii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="60.84%" prev="ii.xi.iii" next="ii.xi.iii.ii" id="ii.xi.iii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.iii.i-p1">David goes up to Hebron and is crowned there, ver. 1-4.
Thanks the men of Jabesh-gilead, ver. 5-7. Ishbosheth is set up in
opposition to him, ver. 8-11. An encounter between David's men and
Ishbosheth's, in which the latter are beaten, ver. 12-17. Asahel is
killed by Abner, ver. 18-23. Joah sounds retreat by the advice of Abner,
who retires to Mahanaim, ver. 24-29. The loss on each side, ver. 30-31.
Asahel buried, ver. 32</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="60.85%" prev="ii.xi.iii.i" next="ii.xi.iv" id="ii.xi.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p1">1. Inquired - By Urim. Thus David begins at the right
end, and lays his foundation in God's counsel and assistance. Shall I go
- He asked not whether he should take the kingdom; for that was
appointed before; and he would not offend God, nor dishonour his
ordinance with unnecessary enquiries; but only where he should enter
upon it; whether in Judah, as he supposed, because of his relation to
that tribe, and his interest in it; or in some other tribe: for he doth
not limit God, but resolves exactly to follow his counsels. Hebron -
Which was next to Jerusalem (part whereof the Jebusites now possessed)
the chief city of that tribe, and a city of the priests, and in the very
center of that tribe, to which the whole tribe might speedily resort,
when need required. And the sepulchres of the patriarchs adjoining to
Hebron, would remind him of the ancient promise.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p2">3. Dwelt in - That is, the cities or towns belonging to
Hebron, which was the Metropolis. For in Hebron itself there was not
space for them all, because it was filled with priests, and with David's
court.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p3">4. Anointed - This they did upon just grounds, because
not only the kingdom was promised to that tribe, but David was designed
and anointed by God, whose will both they and all Israel were obliged to
obey. And they resolved not to neglect their duty, though they saw the
other tribes would. Yet their modesty is observable, they make him king
of Judah only, and not of all Israel. And therefore there was need of a
third anointing to the kingdom over all Israel, which he had chap. v, 3,
that first anointing; <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xvi. 13" id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|1Sam|16|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.16.13">1 Sam. xvi, 13</scripRef>, was only a designation of the person who should be king,
but not an actual inauguration of him to the kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p4">5. Kindness - This respect and affection. For as it is,
an act of inhumanity to deny burial to the dead; so it is an act of
mercy and kindness to bury them.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p5">6. Kindness and truth - That is, true and real kindness;
not in words only, but also in actions, as you have done to your king. I
will requite - So far am I from being offended with you for this
kindness to my late enemy.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p6">7. Be valiant - Be not afraid lest the Philistines should
punish you for this fact, but take good courage, I will defend you. For,
&amp;c. - Or, though your master Saul be dead, and so your hearts may
faint, as if you were now sheep without a shepherd.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p7">8. Abner - Tho' ambition and desire of rule, because he
knew that Ishbosheth would have only the name of king, whilst he had the
power.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p8">9. Gilead - Largely so taken, for all the land of Israel
beyond Jordan. Ashurites - That is, the tribe of Asher, as the Chaldee
paraphrast and others understand it. Jezreel - A large and rich valley
situate in the borders of the tribes of Zebulun, Issachar and Naphtali,
and so put for them all. All Israel - Except Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p9">10. Two years - Namely, before the following war broke
out, which continued five years.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p10">12. Went out - To fight with David's army, and to bring
back the rest of the kingdom to Saul's house.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p11">13. Met - That is, met the opposite army, and put
themselves in a posture for battle.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p12">14. And play - That is, shew their prowess and dexterity
in fighting together. He speaks like a vain-glorious and cruel man, and
a soldier of fortune, that esteemed it a sport to see men wounding and
killing one another. So this he designed, partly for their mutual
recreation and trial of skill; and partly, that by this occasion they
might be engaged in a battle. But he is unworthy the name of a man, who
is thus prodigal of human blood.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p13">16. By the head - By the hair of the head, which after
their manner was of a considerable length. Helkath-kazzurim - Or, the
field of rock; that is, of men who stood like rocks unmovable, each one
dying upon the spot where he fought.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p14">21. And take, &amp;c. - If thou art ambitious to get a
trophy or mark of thy valour, desist from me who am an old and
experienced captain, and go to some young and raw soldier; try thy skill
upon him, and take away his arms from him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p15">23. And died - So Asahel's swiftness, which he presumed
on so much, only forwarded his fate! With it he ran upon his death,
instead of running from it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p16">26. Bitterness - It will produce dreadful effects.
Brethren - By nation and religion: whom therefore they should not pursue
with so fierce a rage, as if they were pursuing the Philistines.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p17">27. Unless, &amp;c. - Unless thou hadst made the motion
that they should fight, ver. 14. It was thou, not I, that gave the first
occasion of this fight. Abner was the sole cause of this war; otherwise
all things had been ended by an amicable agreement: which might have
been made that very morning, if he had so pleased.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iii.ii-p18">32. In Bethlehem - The rest they buried in the field of
battle, but Asahel in the sepulchre of his father. Thus are distinctions
made upon earth, even between the dust of some and of others! But in the
resurrection no difference will be made but between good and bad; which
will remain forever.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="60.94%" prev="ii.xi.iii.ii" next="ii.xi.iv.i" id="ii.xi.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. III" id="ii.xi.iv-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="60.94%" prev="ii.xi.iv" next="ii.xi.iv.ii" id="ii.xi.iv.i">

<p id="ii.xi.iv.i-p1">David's success and sons, ver. 1-5. Abner's quarrel with
Isbosheth, ver. 6-11. His treaty with David, ver. 12-16. He undertakes
to bring Israel over to David, ver. 17-21. Joab murders Abner, ver.
22-27. David's concern and mourning over him, ver. 28-39.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="60.94%" prev="ii.xi.iv.i" next="ii.xi.v" id="ii.xi.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p1">1. Long war - For five years longer: for it is probable,
Isbosheth was made king presently upon Saul's death; and the other
tribes did not submit to David before seven years were expired.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p2">3. Geshur - A part of Syria, northward from the land of
Israel. Her he married, as it may seem, in policy, that he might have a
powerful friend and ally to assist him against Ishbosheth's party in the
north, whilst himself opposed him in the southern parts. But he paid
dear for making piety give place to policy, as the history of Absolom
sheweth.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p3">5. Eglah - This is added, either because she was of
obscure parentage, and was known by no other title but her relation to
David: or, because this was his first and most proper wife, best known
by her other name of Michal, who, though she had no child by David after
she scoffed at him for dancing before the ark, chap. vi, 23, yet might
have one before that time. And she might be named the last, because she
was given away from David, and married to another man. Six sons in seven
years. Some have had as numerous an offspring, and with much more honour
and comfort, by one wife. And we know not that any of the six were
famous: but three were very infamous.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p4">6. Strong - He used all his endeavours to support Saul's
house: which is mentioned, to shew the reason of his deep resentment of
the following aspersion.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p5">12. Messengers - Who in his name might treat with David
concerning his reconciliation with him. Thus God over-rules the passions
of wicked men, to accomplish his own wise and holy purposes. And who
then dare contend with that God who makes even his enemies to do his
work, and destroy themselves? Whose, &amp;c. - To whom doth this whole
land belong, but to thee? Is it not thine by Divine right?</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p6">14. Ishbosheth - Whose consent was necessary, both to
take her away from her present husband, and to persuade her to return to
David. Hereby also David opened to him a door of hope for his
reconciliation, lest being desperate he should hinder Abner in his
present design. My wife - Who, though she was taken from me by force,
and constrained to marry another, yet is my rightful wife. David demands
her, both for the affection he still retained to her, and upon a
political consideration that she might strengthen his title to the
kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p7">19. Benjamin - To these he particularly applies himself,
because they might be thought most kind to Saul and his house, and most
loath to let the kingdom go out of their own tribe; and therefore it was
necessary that he should use all his art and power with them, to
persuade them to a compliance with his design; and besides, they were a
valiant tribe, and bordering upon Judah, and situate between them and
the other tribes; and therefore the winning of them, would be of mighty
concernment to bring in all the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p8">22. A troop - Of robbers, or Philistines, who taking
advantage of the discord between the houses of Saul and David, made
inroads into Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p9">29. Let it, &amp;c. - But would not a resolute punishment
of the murderer himself have become David better, than this passionate
imprecation on his posterity?</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p10">30. Abishai - For though Joab only committed the murder,
yet Abishai was guilty of it, because it was done with his consent, and
counsel, and approbation. In battle - Which he did for his own necessary
defense; and therefore it was no justification of this treacherous
murder.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p11">31. Joab - Him he especially obliged to it, to bring him
to repentance for his sin, and to expose him to public shame. Followed -
That is, attending upon his corps, and paying him that respect which was
due to his quality. Though this was against the usage of kings, and
might seem below David's dignity; yet it was now expedient to vindicate
himself from all suspicion of concurrence in this action.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p12">33. As a fool - That is, as a wicked man. Was he cut off
by the hand of justice for his crimes? Nothing less; but by Joab's
malice and treachery. It is a sad thing to die as a fool dieth, as they
do that any way shorten their own days: and indeed all they that make no
provision for another world.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p13">34. Not bound - Thou didst not tamely yield up thyself to
Joab, to be bound hand and foot at his pleasure. Joab did not overcome
thee in an equal combat, nor durst he attempt thee in that way, as a
general or soldier of any worth would have done. Wicked men - By the
hands of froward, or perverse, or crooked men, by hypocrisy and
perfidiousness, whereby the vilest coward may kill the most valiant
person.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p14">36. Pleased them - They were satisfied concerning David's
integrity.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p15">38. Know ye not, &amp;c. - But how little, how mean are
they made by death, who were the terror of the mighty in the land of the
living.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.iv.ii-p16">39. Weak - In the infancy of my kingdom, not well settled
in it. The metaphor is taken from a young and tender child or plant.
These men - Joab and Abishai, the sons of thy sister Zeruiah. Too hard -
That is, too powerful. They have so great a command over all the
soldiers, and so great favour with the people, that I cannot punish them
without apparent hazard to my person and kingdom; especially, now when
all the tribes, except Judah, are in a state of opposition against me.
But although this might give some colour to the delay of their
punishment, yet it was a fault that he did not do it within some
reasonable time, both because this indulgence proceeded from a distrust
of God's power and faithfulness; as if God could not make good his
promise to him, against Joab and all his confederates; and because it
was contrary to God's law, which severally requires the punishment of
willful murderers. It was therefore carnal wicked policy, yea cruel pity
that spared him. If the law had had its course against Joab, it is
probable the murder of Ishbosheth, Ammon, and others, had been
prevented. So truly was he in these, and some other respects, a bloody
man, which may be observed to the glory of the Divine grace, in his
forgiveness and conversion.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="61.05%" prev="ii.xi.iv.ii" next="ii.xi.v.i" id="ii.xi.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. IV" id="ii.xi.v-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="61.05%" prev="ii.xi.v" next="ii.xi.v.ii" id="ii.xi.v.i">

<p id="ii.xi.v.i-p1">Two of his servants murder Ishbosheth, and bring his head
to David, ver. 1-8. He puts them to death, ver. 9-52.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="61.05%" prev="ii.xi.v.i" next="ii.xi.vi" id="ii.xi.v.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.v.ii-p1">4. Jonathan had a son - This history is inserted as that
which encouraged these men to this wicked murder, because Saul's family
was now reduced to a low ebb; and if Isbosheth was dispatched, there
would be none left, but a lame child, who was altogether unfit to manage
the kingdom, and therefore the crown must necessarily come to David by
their act and deed; for which they promised themselves no small
recompense. Jezreel - The place of that last and fatal fight.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.v.ii-p2">6. Fetched wheat - Which was laid up in publick granaries
in the king's house, and was fetched thence by the captains and
commanders of the army for the pay of their soldiers, who, in those
ancient times were not paid in money, but in corn. Upon this pretense
they were admitted into the house, and so went from room to room, to the
place where the king lay.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.v.ii-p3">12. David commanded. &amp;c.But what a disappointment to
Baanah and Rechab, was the sentence which David passed upon them! And
such they will meet with, who think to serve the Son of David, by
cruelty or injustice: who under colour of religion, outrage or murder of
their brethren, think they do God service. However men may now canonize
such methods of serving the church and the catholic cause, Christ will
let them know another day, that Christianity was not designed to destroy
humanity. And they who thus think to merit heaven, shall not escape the
damnation of hell.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="61.08%" prev="ii.xi.v.ii" next="ii.xi.vi.i" id="ii.xi.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. V" id="ii.xi.vi-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="61.08%" prev="ii.xi.vi" next="ii.xi.vi.ii" id="ii.xi.vi.i">

<p id="ii.xi.vi.i-p1">David is anointed king by all the tribes, ver. 1-5. Takes
the strong hold of Zion, ver. 6-10. David builds him an house; his
kingdom is established, ver. 11, 12. Has more children, ver. 13- 16.
Conquers the Philistines, ver. 17-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="61.08%" prev="ii.xi.vi.i" next="ii.xi.vii" id="ii.xi.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p1">2. Shalt feed - That is, rule them, and take care of
them, as a shepherd doth of his sheep, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxviii. 70, 71" id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Ps|78|70|78|71" osisRef="Bible:Ps.78.70-Ps.78.71">Psalm lxxviii, 70, 71</scripRef>. This expression, he useth to admonish David, that he was
not made a king to advance his own glory, but for the good of his
people; whom he ought to rule with all tenderness, and to watch over
with all diligence.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p2">3. A league - Whereby David obliged himself to rule them
according to God's laws; and the people promised obedience to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p3">6. Cannot come - They confided in the strength of their
fortifications, which they thought so impregnable, that the blind and
the lame were sufficient to defend them, against the most powerful
assailant. And probably they set a parcel of blind and lame people,
invalids or maimed soldiers, to make their appearance on the wall, in
contempt of David and his men.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p4">8. To the gutter - That is, whosoever scaleth the fort,
or getteth up to the top of it, where the gutter was. That are hated -
The Jebusites, and the lame, and the blind, Who had probably themselves
insulted him, and blasphemed God. He shall be - These words are fitly
supplied out of <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 6" id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Chr|11|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.6">1 Chron. xi, 6</scripRef>, where they are expressed. They said &amp;c. - That is,
whence it became a proverb, or a common saying, used by David, and
others, the blind and the lame Jebusites, were set to keep the house,
that is, the fort of Zion; and to keep others from coming into it; but
now they are shut out of it, and none of them, either of the Jebusites,
or of blind and lame persons, shall be admitted to come into it again.
Which David might ordain, to keep up the memory of this great exploit,
and of the insolent carriage of the Jebusites.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p5">9. Millo - Which seems to have been the town-hall or,
state-house, near the wall of the city of Zion.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p6">12. King over Israel - That he might be a blessing to
them, and they might be happy under his administration.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p7">13. David took, &amp;c. - This may well be reckoned
amongst David's miscarriages, the multiplication of wives being expresly
forbidden to the king, <scripRef passage="Deut. xvii. 17" id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Deut|17|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.17.17">Deut. xvii, 17</scripRef>. It seems to have been his policy, that hereby he might
enlarge his family, and strengthen his interest by alliances with so
many considerable families. But all these did not preserve him from
coveting his neighbour's wife. Rather they inclined him to it: for men
who have once broke the fence, will wander carelesly.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p8">17. The hold - To some fortified place to which his
people might conveniently resort from all places, and where he might
intrench his army, which lay towards the Philistines.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p9">20. Baal-perazim-Whither the Philistines were come from
the valley of Rephraim, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xiv. 11" id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|1Chr|14|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.14.11">1 Chron. xiv, 11</scripRef>. Baal-perazim, signifies the master of the breaches: So he
ascribes all to God. As waters - As floods or rivers of waters, which
break the banks, and overflow a land, and overturn all that stands in
their way.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p10">21. Images - When the ark fell into the hand of the
Philistines, it consumed them: but when these images fell into the hands
of Israel, they could not save themselves from being consumed.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p11">22. And spread themselves - The expression intimates,
that they were very numerous, and made a very formidable appearance. So
we read, <scripRef passage="Rev. xx. 9" id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Rev|20|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.20.9">Rev. xx, 9</scripRef>, of the church's enemies going up on the breadth of the
earth. But the wider they spread themselves, the fairer mark they are
for God's arrows.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p12">23. Go up - Directly against them, as the following words
explain it. Behind - Where they least expect thee; God's purposes and
promises do not exclude men's endeavours.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vi.ii-p13">24. The sound - A noise as it were of persons walking
upon the tops of them, which I shall cause; and by this sign, both thou
shalt he assured that I am coming to help thee; and the Philistines
shall be affrighted, and not perceive the noise of thy army, until thou
art upon them. Bestir - Fall upon them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="61.15%" prev="ii.xi.vi.ii" next="ii.xi.vii.i" id="ii.xi.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. VI" id="ii.xi.vii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="61.15%" prev="ii.xi.vii" next="ii.xi.vii.ii" id="ii.xi.vii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.vii.i-p1">The ark is brought from the house of Abinadab, ver. 1-5.
Its progress stopped by the death of Uzzah, ver. 6-11. It is brought
into the city of David with solemn rejoicings, ver. 12-19. David answers
the reproof of Michal, ver. 20-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="61.15%" prev="ii.xi.vii.i" next="ii.xi.viii" id="ii.xi.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p1">2. On which, &amp;c. - That is, by, or before which, they
were to present their prayers to God for counsel and succor upon all
occasions. And this is mentioned here as the reason why David put
himself and his people to so great trouble and charge, because it was to
fetch up the choicest treasure which they had.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p2">3. They set, &amp;c. - Being taught, and encouraged to do
so, by the example of the Philistines, who did so without any token of
God's displeasure upon them for so doing. But they did not sufficiently
consider, that God might wink at the Philistines, because they were
ignorant of God's laws; and yet be angry with them for the same thing,
because they knew, or might have known the law of God, which commanded
the priests to bear it upon their shoulders. But their present
transports of joy of the happy change of their affairs, and their greedy
desire of having the ark of God removed, made them inconsiderate. In
Gibeah - Or, on the hill, as <scripRef passage="1 Sam. vii. 1" id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|1Sam|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.7.1">1 Sam.
vii, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p3">5. Played before the Lord - Public joy should always be
as before the Lord, with an eye to him, and terminating in him.
Otherwise it is no better than public madness, and the source of all
manner of wickedness.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p4">7. He died - This may seem very severe, considering his
intention was pious, and his transgression not great. But, besides that,
men are improper Judges of the actions of God; and that God's judgments
are always just, though sometimes obscure: it is reasonable, God should
make some present examples of his high displeasure against sins,
seemingly small; partly, for the demonstration of his own exact and
impartial holiness; partly, for the establishment of discipline, and for
the greater terror and caution of mankind, who are very prone to have
slight thoughts of sin, and to give way to small sins, and thereby to be
led on to greater; all which is, or may be prevented by such instances
of severity: and consequently there is more of God's mercy, than of his
justice, in such actions, because the justice is confined to one
particular person, but the benefit of it common to mankind in that, and
all future ages.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p5">8. Displeased - Or, grieved, both for the sin, and for
God's heavy judgment; whereby their hopes were dashed, and their joys
interrupted. Perez-uzzah - That is, the breach of Uzzah.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p6">10. House of Obed-edom - Obed-edom knew what slaughter
the ark had made among the Philistines and the Bethshemites. He saw
Uzzah struck dead; yet invites it to his house, and opens his doors
without fear, knowing it was a savour of death, only to them that
treated it ill. "O the courage, says Bishop Hall, of an honest and
faithful heart! Nothing can make God otherwise than amiable to him: even
his justice is lovely."</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p7">11. The Lord blessed, &amp;c. - The same hand that
punished Uzzah's presumption, rewarded Obed-edom's humble boldness. None
ever had, or ever shall have reason to say, that it is in vain to serve
God. Piety is the best friend to prosperity. His household too shared in
the blessing. It is good living in a family that entertains the ark; for
all about it will fare the better for it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p8">14. Danced - To express his thankfulness to God by his
outward carriage, according to the manner of those times. Linen ephod -
The usual habit of the priests and Levites, in their sacred
ministrations yet sometimes worn by others, as it was by the young child
Samuel; and so David, who laid by his royal robes, and put on this robe
to declare, that although he was king of Israel, yet he willingly owned
himself to be the Lord's minister and servant.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p9">16. Despised - As one of a base and mean spirit, that
knew not how to carry himself with that majesty which became his
place.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p10">17. David had pitched - For Moses tabernacle was still at
Gibeon, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xvi. 39" id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|1Chr|16|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.16.39">1 Chron. xvi, 39</scripRef>; xxi, 29; <scripRef passage="2 Chron. i. 3" id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p10.2" parsed="|2Chr|1|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.1.3">2 Chron. i, 3</scripRef>, which David left there, because he designed to build a
temple at Jerusalem with all speed.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p11">18. He blessed - That is, he heartily and solemnly prayed
to God for his blessing upon them: which he did both as a prophet, and
as their king, to whom by office it belongs, by all means, to seek his
people's welfare.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p12">20. Bless his household - Ministers must not think, that
their public performances will excuse them from family worship: but when
they have blessed the public assembly, they are to return and bless
their own household. And none is too great to do this. It is the work of
angels to worship God; and therefore certainly can be no disparagement
to the greatest of men. Who uncovered - By stripping himself of his
royal robes, that he might put on a Levitical ephod.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p13">21. Before the Lord - In his presence and service, which
though contemptible to thee, is, and ever shall be honourable in mine
eyes. Who chose - Who took away the honour from him and his, and
transferred it unto me, whereby he hath obliged me to love and serve him
with all my might.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p14">22. More vile than thus - The more we are vilified for
well doing, the more resolute therein we should be, binding our religion
the closer to us, for the endeavours of Satan's agents to shame us out
of it. Be base - I will always be ready to abase myself before God, and
think nothing to mean to stoop to for his honour. Be had in honour - So
far will they be from despising me on this account, that they will
honour me the more.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.vii.ii-p15">23. Therefore - Because of her proud and petulant speech
and carriage to David, which God justly punished with barrenness. No
child - After this time.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="61.25%" prev="ii.xi.vii.ii" next="ii.xi.viii.i" id="ii.xi.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. VII" id="ii.xi.viii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="61.25%" prev="ii.xi.viii" next="ii.xi.viii.ii" id="ii.xi.viii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.viii.i-p1">Nathan approves David's design of building an house for
God, ver. 1-3. God forbids it, but promises to bless him and his seed,
ver. 4-17. His prayer and thanksgiving, ver. 18-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="61.25%" prev="ii.xi.viii.i" next="ii.xi.ix" id="ii.xi.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p1">1. Sat - That is, was settled in the house which Hiram's
men had built for him, then he reflected upon the unsettled state of the
ark.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p2">2. Curtains - That is, in a tent or tabernacle, ver. 6,
composed of several curtains.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p3">3. Nathan said - Pursue thy intentions, and build an
house for the ark. The design being pious and the thing not forbidden by
God, Nathan hastily approves it, before he had consulted God about it,
as both he and David ought to have done in a matter of so great moment.
And therefore Nathan meets with this rebuke, that he is forced to
acknowledge his error, and recant it. For the holy prophets did not
speak all things by prophetic inspiration, but some things by an human
spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p4">4. The word of the Lord came - Because David's mistake
was pious, and from an honest mind, God would not suffer him to lie long
in it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p5">5. Shalt thou - That is, thou shalt not.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p6">6. Tent and tabernacle - These two seem thus to be
distinguished, the one may note the curtains and hangings within, the
other the frame of boards, and coverings upon it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p7">8. My servant - Lest David should be too much
discouraged, or judge himself neglected of God, as one thought unworthy
of so great an honour, God here gives him the honourable title of his
servant, thereby signifying that he accepted of his service, and good
intentions.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p8">10. Appoint - That is, I will make room for them, whereas
hitherto they have been much distressed by their enemies. Or, I will
establish a place for them, that is, I will establish them in their
place or land. My people - Among the favours which God had vouchsafed,
and would vouchsafe to David, he reckons his blessings to Israel,
because they were great blessings to David; partly, because the strength
and happiness of a king consists in the multitude and happiness of his
people; and partly, because David was a man of a public spirit, and
therefore no less affected with Israel's felicity than with his own.
Before time - Namely in Egypt.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p9">11. And as since - Nor as they did under the Judges. But
all this is to be understood with a condition, except they should
notoriously forsake God. And have caused thee - That is, and as until
this time in which I have given thee rest. But these words, though
according to our translation they be enclosed in the same parenthesis
with the foregoing clauses, may be better put without it, and taken by
themselves. For the foregoing words in this verse, and in ver. 10, all
concern the people of Israel; but these words concern David alone, to
whom the speechs returns after a short digression concerning the people
of Israel. And they may be rendered thus. And I will cause thee to rest,
&amp;c. - More fully and perfectly than yet thou dost. He will, &amp;c.
- For thy good intentions to make him an house, he will make thee an
house, a sure house, that is, he will increase and uphold thy posterity,
and continue thy kingdom in thy family.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p10">12. And when, &amp;c. - When the time of thy life shall
expire. This phrase implies, that his days shall be prolonged to the
usual course of nature, and not cut off in the midst, by any violent or
untimely death. I will set - I will set up in thy throne, thy posterity,
first Solomon, and then others successively, and at last the Messiah. So
the following words may be understood, part of his posterity in general,
part of Solomon, and part of Christ only, according to the different
nature of the several passages.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p11">13. He shall - This is meant literally of Solomon, who
alone did build the material house or temple; but ultimately of Christ,
who is the builder of God's spiritual house or temple. For my name -
That is, for my service, and glory. For ever - This is not meant of
Solomon, for his kingdom was not forever. But it is to be understood of
David's posterity, in general, and with special respect to Christ, in
whose person the kingdom was to be lodged forever. 14. His father - I
will carry myself towards him as a father, with all affection, and I
will own him as my son. This is intended both of Solomon, as a type of
Christ; and of Christ himself as is evident from <scripRef passage="Heb. i. 5" id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Heb|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.1.5">Heb. i, 5</scripRef>. If he commit - This agrees only to Solomon and some others
of David's posterity; but not to Christ, who never committed iniquity,
as Solomon did, who therein was no type of Christ, and therefore this
branch is terminated in Solomon; whereas in those things wherein Solomon
was a type of Christ, the sense passes through Solomon to Christ. Rod of
men - With such rods as are gentle and moderate, and suited to man's
weakness.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p12">15. My mercy - That is, Or, my kindness, that is, the
kingdom which I have mercifully promised to thee and thine. From Saul -
In regard of his posterity, for the kingdom was continued to his person
during life.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p13">16. Before thee - Thine eyes in some sort beholding it:
for he lived to see his wise son Solomon actually placed in the throne,
with reputation and general applause, which was in itself a good presage
of the continuance of the kingdom in his family: and being considered,
together with the infallible certainty of God's promise to him and his,
(of the accomplishment whereof, this was an earnest,) gave him good
assurance thereof; especially considering that he had his eyes and
thoughts upon the Messiah, <scripRef passage="Psalm cx. 1" id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|Ps|110|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.110.1">Psalm cx, 1</scripRef>, &amp;c. whose day he saw by faith, as Abraham did, <scripRef passage="John viii. 56" id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p13.2" parsed="|John|8|56|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.8.56">John viii, 56</scripRef>, and whom he knew that God would raise out of the fruit of
his loins to sit on his throne, and that forever: and so the eternity
of his kingdom is rightly said to be before him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p14">18. In - Into the tabernacle. Sat - He might sit for a
season whilst he was meditating upon these things, and then alter his
posture and betake himself to prayer. Who am I, &amp;c. - How infinitely
unworthy am I and my family of this great honour and happiness!</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p15">19. This - Which thou hast already done for me, that thou
hast brought me hitherto, to that pitch of honour, and peace, and
prosperity, in which through thy favour I now stand. Was small - Though
it was more than I deserved, or could expect, yet thou didst not think
it enough for thee to give to me. A great while - For many future ages,
and indeed to all eternity. Is this, &amp;c. - Do men use to deal so
kindly with their inferiors, as thou hast done with me? No: this is the
prerogative of divine grace.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p16">20. David say - Either in a way of gratitude and praise,
words cannot express my obligations to thee, nor my sense of these
obligations: Or in a way of prayer. What can I ask of thee more than
thou hast freely done? Thou knowest - Thou knowest my deep sense of thy
favours, and my obligations to thee. And my condition and necessities,
what I do or may need hereafter; and as thou knowest this, so I doubt
not thou wilt supply me.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p17">21. Thy word's sake - That thou mightest fulfil thy
promises made to me, and thereby demonstrate thy faithfulness. Own heart
- Or thy own mere liberality and good pleasure, without any desert of
mine. So far was David, though a very gracious man, from thinking his
actions meritorious.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p18">22. Great - Both in power and in goodness, as appears by
the great and good things which thou hast done for me.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p19">24. Confirmed - Partly, by thy promises, and that sure
covenant which thou hast made with them: and partly, by thy glorious
works wrought on their behalf, as it appears this day. Their God - In a
peculiar manner, and by special relation and covenant: for otherwise he
is the God and father of all things.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p20">26. Let thy name - That is, do thou never cease to
manifest thyself to be the God and governor of Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p21">27. This prayer, &amp;c. - That prayer that is found in
the tongue only will not please God. It must be found in the heart. That
must be lifted up and poured out before God.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p22">28. That God - That God who hast declared thyself to be
Israel's God, and in particular my God.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.viii.ii-p23">29. Continue forever, &amp;c. - When Christ forever sat
down on the right-hand of God, and received all possible assurance, that
his seed and throne should be as the days of heaven, then this prayer
was abundantly answered.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="61.39%" prev="ii.xi.viii.ii" next="ii.xi.ix.i" id="ii.xi.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. VIII" id="ii.xi.ix-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="61.39%" prev="ii.xi.ix" next="ii.xi.ix.ii" id="ii.xi.ix.i">

<p id="ii.xi.ix.i-p1">David subdues the Philistines and Moabites, ver. 1-2.
Smites Hadadezer, and the Syrians, ver. 3-8. Dedicates the presents he
had received and the spoils to God, ver. 9-12. Conquers the Syrians
again, and the Edomites, ver. 13, 14. His administration of justice and
chief officers, ver. 15-18,</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="61.40%" prev="ii.xi.ix.i" next="ii.xi.x" id="ii.xi.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p1">1. And David took - Gath and her towns, as it is
expressed in the parallel place, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xviii. 1" id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p1.1" parsed="|1Chr|18|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.18.1">1 Chron. xviii, 1</scripRef>. Which are called Metheg-ammah, or the bridle of Ammah, Gath
was situate in the mountain of Ammah; and because this being the chief
city of the Philistines, and having a king, which none of the rest had,
was the bridle which had hitherto kept the Israelites in subjection.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p2">2. Moab - For although the king of Moab, out of hatred to
Saul, gave protection to his parents, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxii. 3, 4" id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p2.1" parsed="|1Sam|22|3|22|4" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.22.3-1Sam.22.4">1 Sam. xxii, 3, 4</scripRef>, yet the Moabites were perpetual and sworn enemies to the
Israelites, who therefore were forbidden to admit them into the
congregation of the Lord. And though God commanded them in their march
to Canaan, to spare the Moabites, yet afterwards they proved fierce
enemies to God and his people, and thereby provoked God to alter his
carriage towards them. Measured them - That is, having conquered the
land, he made an estimate of it, and distributed the towns and people
into three parts. Casting down - Overthrowing their towns, and utterly
destroying their people in manner following. And now that prophecy, <scripRef passage="Num. xxiv. 17" id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Num|24|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.24.17">Num. xxiv, 17</scripRef>, was accomplished.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p3">3. As he went - David, remembering the grant which God
had made to his people of all the land as far as Euphrates, and having
subdued his neighbouring enemies, went to recover his rights, and
stablish his dominion as far as Euphrates.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p4">4. Seven hundred - Or, seven hundred companies of
horsemen, that is, in all seven thousand; as it is <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xviii. 4" id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Chr|18|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.18.4">1 Chron. xviii, 4</scripRef>, there being ten in each company, and each ten having a
ruler or captain. Houghed - That is, cut the sinews of their legs, that
they might be useless for war.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p5">5. Of Damascus - That is, who were subject to Damascus,
the chief city of Syria.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p6">7. On the servants - Or rather, which were with the
servants, that is, committed to their custody, as being kept in the
king's armoury: for it is not probable they carried them into the
field.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p7">8. From Betah, &amp;c. - In <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xviii. 8" id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p7.1" parsed="|1Chr|18|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.18.8">1 Chron. xviii, 8</scripRef>, it is, from Tibhath, and from Chun. Either therefore the
same cities were called by several names, as is usual, the one by the
Hebrew, the other by the Syrians, or those were two other cities, and so
the brass was taken out of these four cities.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p8">14. The Lord preserved, &amp;c. - All David's victories
were typical of the success of the gospel over the kingdom of Satan, in
which the Son of David rode forth, conquering and to conquer, and will
reign 'till he has brought down all opposing rule, principality and
power.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p9">16. Recorder - The treasurer, who examined all the
accounts, and kept records of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p10">17. Scribe - Or, secretary of state.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.ix.ii-p11">18. Cherethites, &amp;c. - The Cherethites and Pelethites
were undoubtedly soldiers, and such as were eminent for their valour and
fidelity. Most probable they were the king's guards, which consisted of
these two bands, who might be distinguished either by their several
weapons, or by the differing time or manner of their service. They are
supposed to be thus called either, first, from their office, which was
upon the king's command to cut off or punish offenders, and to preserve
the king's person, as their names in the Hebrew tongue may seem to
imply. Or, secondly, from some country, or place to which they had
relation. As for the Cherithites, it is certain they were ether a branch
of the Philistines, or a people neighbouring to them, and so might the
Pelethites be too, though that be not related in scripture. And these
Israelites and soldiers of David might be so called, either because they
went and lived with David when he dwelt in those parts or, for some
notable exploit against, or victory over these people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="61.46%" prev="ii.xi.ix.ii" next="ii.xi.x.i" id="ii.xi.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. IX" id="ii.xi.x-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="61.46%" prev="ii.xi.x" next="ii.xi.x.ii" id="ii.xi.x.i">

<p id="ii.xi.x.i-p1">David sends for Jonathan's son, Mephibosheth, ver. 1-6.
Restores to him all the land that was Saul's, and appoints him to eat at
his own table, ver. 7-13.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="61.46%" prev="ii.xi.x.i" next="ii.xi.xi" id="ii.xi.x.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.x.ii-p1">1. Of Saul - He saith not of the house of Jonathan, for
he knew not of any son he had left, and therefore thought his kindness
and obligation was to pass to the next of his kindred. As for
Mephibosheth, he was very young and obscure, and possibly concealed by
his friends, lest David should cut him off, as hath been usual among
princes.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.x.ii-p2">5. Machir - This Machir appears to have been a generous
man, who entertained Mephibosheth out of mere compassion, not of
disaffection to David: for afterwards we find him kind to David himself,
when he fled from Absalom. David now little thought, that the time would
come, when he himself should need his assistance. Let us be forward to
give, because we know not what we ourselves may sometime want.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.x.ii-p3">8. Bowed himself - It is good to have the heart humbled
under humbling providences. If when divine providence brings our
condition down, divine grace brings our spirits down, we shall be
easy.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="61.48%" prev="ii.xi.x.ii" next="ii.xi.xi.i" id="ii.xi.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. X" id="ii.xi.xi-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="61.48%" prev="ii.xi.xi" next="ii.xi.xi.ii" id="ii.xi.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xi.i-p1">David's ambassadors are abused by Hanun, ver. 1-4. The
Ammonites prepare for war and are routed, ver. 5-14. Their allies, the
Syrians rally and are defeated again, ver. 15-19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="61.48%" prev="ii.xi.xi.i" next="ii.xi.xii" id="ii.xi.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xi.ii-p1">2. David sent - There had hitherto been friendship
between David and him: and therefore the spoils of the children of Ammon
are mentioned, chap. viii, 12, by way of anticipation, and with respect
to the story here following.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xi.ii-p2">4. Shaved - To fasten this is a reproach upon them, and
to make them ridiculous and contemptible. Cut off, &amp;c. - This was
worse than the former, because the Israelites wore no breeches, and so
their nakedness was hereby uncovered.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xi.ii-p3">19. And served them - And thus at length was fulfilled
the promise made to Abraham, and repeated to Joshua, that the borders of
Israel should extend as far as the river Euphrates. The son of David
sent his ambassadors, his apostles and ministers, to the Jewish church
and nation. But they intreated them shamefully, as Hanun did David's,
mocked them, abused them, slew them. And this it was that filled the
measure of their iniquity, and brought upon them ruin without
remedy.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="61.50%" prev="ii.xi.xi.ii" next="ii.xi.xii.i" id="ii.xi.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XI" id="ii.xi.xii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="61.50%" prev="ii.xi.xii" next="ii.xi.xii.ii" id="ii.xi.xii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xii.i-p1">David commits adultery with Bathsheba, ver. 1-5.
endeavours to father the child upon Uriah, ver. 6-13. Contrives the
death of Uriah, ver. 14-25. Marries Bathsheba, ver. 26, 27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="61.50%" prev="ii.xi.xii.i" next="ii.xi.xiii" id="ii.xi.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p1">1. After - When that year ended, and the next begun,
which was in the spring time. When kings - Which is, when the ground is
fit for the march of soldiers, and brings forth provision for man and
beast. Tarried at Jerusalem - Had he been now in his post, at the head
of his forces be had been out of the way of temptation.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p2">2. Arose from off his bed - Where he had lain, and slept
for some time. And the bed of sloth often proves the bed of lust.
Washing herself - In a bath, which was in her garden. Probably from some
ceremonial pollution.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p3">3. He inquired - Instead of suppressing that desire which
the sight of his eyes had kindled, he seeks rather to feed it; and first
inquires who she was; that if she were unmarried, he might make her
either his wife or his concubine.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p4">4. Took her - From her own house into his palace, not by
force, but by persuasion. Lay with her - See how all the way to sin is
down hill! When men begin, they cannot soon stop themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p5">8. Go down - Not doubting but he would there converse
with his wife, and so cover their sin and shame.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p6">9. The servants - With the king's guard. This he did, by
the secret direction of God's wise providence, who would bring David's
sin to light.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p7">10. Camest - Wearied with hard service and travel, nor
did I expect or desire that thou shouldest now attend upon my person, or
keep the watch.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p8">11. The ark - This it seems, was now carried with them
for their encouragement and direction, as was usual. Fields - In tents
which are in the fields. His meaning is, now, when God's people are in a
doubtful and dangerous condition, it becomes me to sympathize with them,
and to abstain even from lawful delights.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p9">15. He arose - So far is David from repenting, that he
seeks to cover one sin with another. How are the beginnings of sin to be
dreaded! For who knows where it will end? David hath sinned, therefore
Uriah must die! That innocent, valiant, gallant man, who was ready to
die for his prince's honour, must die by his prince's hand! See how
fleshly lusts war against the soul, and what devastations they make in
that war! How they blind the eyes, fear the conscience, harden the
heart, and destroy all sense of honour and justice!</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xii.ii-p10">27. The mourning - Which was seven days. Nor could the
nature of the thing admit of longer delay, lest the too early birth of
the child might discover David's sin. Bare a son - By which it appears,
That David continued in the state of impenitency for divers months
together; and this notwithstanding his frequent attendance upon God's
ordinances. Which is an eminent instance of the corruption of man's
nature, of the deceitfulness of sin, and of the tremendous judgment of
God in punishing one sin, by delivering a man up to another.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="61.55%" prev="ii.xi.xii.ii" next="ii.xi.xiii.i" id="ii.xi.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XII" id="ii.xi.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="61.55%" prev="ii.xi.xiii" next="ii.xi.xiii.ii" id="ii.xi.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.i-p1">Nathan delivers and applies his parable, ver. 1-12. David
repents and is forgiven, but punished, ver. 13. 14. The sickness and
death of the child, with David's behaviour on the occasion, ver. 15-23.
The birth of Solomon, ver. 24-25. The taking of Rabbah, ver. 26-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="61.56%" prev="ii.xi.xiii.i" next="ii.xi.xiv" id="ii.xi.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p1">1. The Lord sent - When the ordinary means did not awaken
David to repentance, God takes an extraordinary course. Thus the
merciful God pities and prevents him who had so horribly forsaken God.
He said - He prudently ushers in his reproof with a parable, after the
manner of the eastern nations, that so he might surprize David, and
cause him unawares to give sentence against himself.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p2">2. Many flocks - Noting David's many wives and
concubines.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p3">3. Bought - As men then used to buy their wives: or, had
procured.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p4">5. Is worthy to die - This seems to be more than the fact
deserved, or than he had commission to inflict for it, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxii. 1" id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Exod|22|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.22.1">Exod. xxii, 1</scripRef>. But it is observable, that David now when he was most
indulgent to himself, and to his own sin, was most severe and even
unjust to others; as appears by this passage, and the following
relation, ver. 31, which was done in the time of David's impenitent
continuance in his sin.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p5">7. Thus saith the Lord God - Nathan now speaks, not as a
petitioner for a poor man, but as an ambassador from the great God.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p6">9. To be thy wife - To marry her whom he had defiled, and
whose husband he had slain, was an affront upon the ordinance of
marriage, making that not only to palliate, but in a manner to
consecrate such villainies. In all this he despised the word of the
Lord; (so it is in the Hebrew.) Not only his commandment in general, but
the particular word of promise, which God had before sent him by Nathan,
that he would build him an house: which sacred promise if he had had a
due value for, he would not have polluted his house with lust and
blood.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p7">10. Never depart - During the residue of thy life.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p8">11. Own house - From thy own children and family. Thine
eyes - Openly, so that thou shalt know it as certainly as if thou didst
see it, and yet not be able to hinder it. And give them - I shall by my
providence, give him power over them. neighbour - To one who is very
near thee. But God expresseth this darkly, that the accomplishment of it
might not be hindered.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p9">13. I have sinned - How serious this confession was, we
may see, <scripRef passage="Psalm li. 1-19" id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Ps|51|1|51|19" osisRef="Bible:Ps.51.1-Ps.51.19">Psalm li, 1-19</scripRef>. Put away thy sin - That is, so far as concerns thy own
life. Not die - As by thy own sentence, ver. 5, thou dost deserve, and
may expect to be done by my immediate stroke.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p10">16. Besought - Supposing the threatening might be
conditional, and so the execution of it prevented by prayer. Went - Into
his closet.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p11">17. Elders - The chief officers of his kingdom and
household. He would not - This excessive mourning did not proceed simply
from the fear of the loss of the child; but from a deep sense of his
sin, and the divine displeasure manifested herein.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p12">18. Seventh day - From the beginning of the
distemper.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p13">20. And came - That is, to the tabernacle, to confess his
sin before the Lord, to own his justice in this stroke, to deprecate his
just displeasure, to acknowledge God's rich mercy, in sparing his own
life; and to offer such sacrifices as were required in such cases.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p14">23. I fast - Seeing fasting and prayer cannot now prevail
with God for his life. I shall go to him - Into the state of the dead in
which he is, and into heaven, where I doubt not I shall find him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p15">24. His wife - Who was now much dejected, both for her
former sin, and for the loss of the child. Loved him - That is, the Lord
declared to David, that he loved his son, notwithstanding the just cause
David had given to God to alienate his affections from him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p16">25. Jedidiah - That is, beloved of the Lord. Because -
Either, because of the Lord's love to him, or because the Lord commanded
him to do so.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p17">26. Royal city - That is, that part of the city where was
the king's palace; though now it seems he was retired to a strong
fort.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p18">27. Of waters - Rabbah was so called because it was
encompassed with water.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p19">28. Take it - For having taken one part of the city, he
concluded the remaining part of it could not long stand out. Lest - Lest
I have the honour of taking it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p20">30. The weight - Or rather, the price whereof, &amp;c.
For the same words both in Hebrew, Greek and Latin, are used, to signify
either weight, or price. And the addition of precious stones, which are
never valued by the weight of gold, makes this signification most
probable. Moreover, the weight might seem too great either for the king
of Ammon, or for David to wear it upon his head.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiii.ii-p21">31. The people - The words are indefinite, and therefore
not necessarily to be understood of all the people; but of the men of
war, and especially of those who had been the chief actors of that
villainous action against David's ambassadors, and of the dreadful war
ensuing upon it; for which, they deserved severe punishments. Altho'
indeed there seems to have been too much rigor used; especially, because
these deaths were inflicted not only upon those counsellors, who were
the only authors of that vile usage of the ambassadors; but upon some
number of the people. And therefore it is probable, David exercised this
cruelty whilst his heart was hardened, and impenitent; and when he was
bereaved of that good spirit of God, which would have taught him more
mercy. Saws - He sawed them to death of which punishment, we have
examples both in scripture, and in other authors. Brick-kiln - Or, made
them to pass through the furnace of Malchen: that is, of Moloch;
punishing them with their own sin, and with the same kind of punishment
which they had inflicted upon their own children.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="61.65%" prev="ii.xi.xiii.ii" next="ii.xi.xiv.i" id="ii.xi.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XIII" id="ii.xi.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="61.65%" prev="ii.xi.xiv" next="ii.xi.xiv.ii" id="ii.xi.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.i-p1">Amnon ravishes Tamar, ver. 1-20. Absalom kills him, ver.
21-29. David mourns: Absalom flees to Geshur, ver. 30-39.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="61.65%" prev="ii.xi.xiv.i" next="ii.xi.xv" id="ii.xi.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p1">1. A sister - His sister by father and mother.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p2">2. A virgin - And therefore diligently kept, so he could
not get private converse with her.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p3">5. My sister - So he calls her, to prevent the suspicion
of any dishonest design upon so near a relation. At her hand -
Pretending, his stomach was so nice, that he could eat nothing but what
he saw dressed, and that by a person whom he much esteemed.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p4">9. Out - Out of the frying-pan into the dish.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p5">10. Chamber - Amnon lying upon his couch in one chamber
where the company were with him, where also she made the cakes before
him, first sends all out of that room, and then rises from his couch,
and, upon some pretense, goes into another secret chamber.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p6">12. Brother - Whom nature both teaches to abhor such
thoughts and obliges to defend me from such a mischief with thy utmost
hazard, if another should attempt it. Force - Thou shouldst abhor it, if
I were willing; but to add violence, is abominable. Israel - Among God's
people who are taught better things; who also will be infinitely
reproached for such a base action.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p7">13. Shame - How can I either endure or avoid the shame?
Fools - That is, contemptible to all the people, whereas now thou art
heir apparent of the crown. Withhold - This she spoke, because she
thought her royal father would dispense with it, upon this extraordinary
occasion, to save his first-born son's life:</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p8">15. Hated her - By the just judgment of God both upon
Amnon and David, that so the sin might be made publick, and way for the
succeeding tragedies.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p9">16. No cause - For me to go. Greater thou the other -
This she might truly say, because though the other was in itself a
greater sin, yet this was an act of greater cruelty, and a greater
calamity to her because it exposed her to publick infamy and contempt,
and besides, it turned a private offense into a publick scandal, to the
great dishonour of God and of his people, and especially of all the
royal family.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p10">18. Garment - Of embroidered work.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p11">19. Put ashes - To signify her grief for some calamity
which had befallen her, and what that was, concurring circumstances
easily discovered. Head - In token of grief and shame, as if she were
unable and ashamed to shew her face. Crying - To manifest her abhorrency
of the fact, and that it was not done by her consent.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p12">20. Been with thee - Behold, and imitate the modesty of
scripture expressions. Brother - Wherefore thou must forgive and forgot
the injury; therefore thy disgracing of him will be a blot to us all;
therefore thou wilt not get right from David against him, because he is
as near and dear to him as thou; therefore thy dishonour is the less,
because thou wast not abused by any mean person, but by a king's son;
therefore this evil must be born, because it cannot be revenged: and
thus he covers his design of taking vengeance upon him at the first
opportunity. Regard not - So as to torment thyself. Desolate - Through
shame and dejection of mind, giving her self up to solitude and
retirement.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p13">21. Wroth - With Amnon: whom yet he did not punish, at
least so severely as he should either from the consciousness of his own
guilt in the like kind; or, from that foolish indulgence which he often
shewed to his children.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p14">22. Spake - That is, he said nothing at all to him, about
that business. He neither debated it with him, nor threatened him for
it; but seemed willing to pass it by with brotherly kindness. If he had
wholly forborne all discourse with him, it would have raised jealousies
in Amnon and David.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p15">23. Two years - This circumstance of time is noted, as an
aggravation of Absalom's malice, which was so implacable: and as an act
of policy, that both Amnon and David might more securely comply with his
desires.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p16">26. Let Amnon - For the king designed (as the following
words shew) to keep him at home with him, as being his eldest son, and
heir of his kingdom: otherwise Absalom would never have made particular
mention of him; which now he was forced to do. Nor did this desire of
Amnon's presence want specious pretenses, as that seeing the king would
not, he who was next to him might, honour him with his company; and that
this might be a publick token of friendship between him and his brother,
notwithstanding the former occasion of difference.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p17">27. Pressed him - It is strange that his urgent desire of
Amnon's company raised no suspicion in so wise a king; but God suffered
him to be blinded that he might execute his judgments upon David, and
bring upon Amnon the just punishment of his lewdness.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p18">28. Merry - When he least suspects, and will be most
unable to prevent the evil. I - I who am the king's son, and, when Amnon
is gone, his heir: who therefore shall easily obtain pardon for you, and
will liberally reward you.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p19">29. Commanded - Now the threatened sword is drawn in
David's house, which will not depart from it. His eldest son falls by
it, thro' his own wickedness, and his father by his connivance is
accessory to it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p20">37. Talmai - His mother's father, that he might have
present protection and sustenance from him; and that by his mediation he
might obtain his father's pardon.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xiv.ii-p21">39. Go forth - And could not he recalled, to visit him,
or to send for him. What amazing weakness was this! At first he could
not find in his heart, to do justice to the ravisher of his sister! And
now he can almost find in his heart to receive into favour the murderer
of his brother? How can we excuse David from the sin of Eli; who
honoured his sons more than God?</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="61.75%" prev="ii.xi.xiv.ii" next="ii.xi.xv.i" id="ii.xi.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XIV" id="ii.xi.xv-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="61.75%" prev="ii.xi.xv" next="ii.xi.xv.ii" id="ii.xi.xv.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xv.i-p1">The story told David of the widow of Tekoah, ver. 1-20.
Absalom is brought back to Jerusalem, but not to court, ver. 21- 24. An
account of Absalom's person and children, ver. 21-27. He is at length
introduced to David, ver. 28-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="61.76%" prev="ii.xi.xv.i" next="ii.xi.xvi" id="ii.xi.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p1">1. Was towards - He desired to see him, but was ashamed
to shew kindness to one whom God's law and his own conscience obliged
him to punish; he wanted therefore a fair pretense, which therefore Joab
gave him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p2">2. Anoint - As they used to do when they were out of a
mourning state.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p3">5. Widow - One of them who most need thy compassion, and
whom thou art by God's law obliged in a singular manner to relieve.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p4">9. Be guiltless - If through thy forgetfulness or neglect
of this my just cause, my adversaries prevail and destroy my son, my
desire is, that God would not lay it to the king's charge, but rather to
me and mine, so the king may be exempted thereby. Whereby she
insinuates, that such an omission will bring guilt upon him; and yet
most decently orders her phrase so as not to seem to blame or threaten
the king. This sense seems best to agree with David's answer, which
shew's that she desired some farther assurances of the king's care.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p5">11. Remember - Remember the Lord, in whose presence thou
hast made me this promise, and who will be a witness against thee, if
thou breakest it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p6">13. Wherefore then - If thou shouldst not permit the
avengers of blood to molest me, or to destroy my son, who are but two
persons; how unreasonable is it that thou shouldest proceed in thy
endeavours to avenge Amnon's blood upon Absalom, whose death would be
grievous to the whole commonwealth of Israel, all whose eyes are upon
him as the heir of the crown, and a wise, and valiant, and amiable
person, unhappy only in this one act of killing Amnon, which was done
upon an high provocation, and whereof thou thyself didst give the
occasion by permitting Amnon to go unpunished? Faulty - By thy word, and
promise, and oath given to me for my son, thou condemnest thyself for
not allowing the same equity towards thy own son. It is true, Absalom's
case was widely different from that which she had supposed. But David
was too well affected to him, to remark that difference, and was more
desirous than she could be, to apply that favourable judgment to his own
son, which he had given concerning hers.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p7">14. We - We shall certainly die, both thou, O king, who
art therefore obliged to take care of thy successor, Absalom; and
Absalom, who, if he do not die by the hand of justice, must shortly die
by the necessity of nature: and Amnon too must have died in the common
way of all flesh, if Absalom had not cut him off. Respect - So far as to
exempt him from this common law of dying. Not expelled - He hath given
laws to this purpose, that the man-slayer who is banished should not
always continue in banishment, but upon the High-priest's death return
to his own city.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p8">15. The people - The truth is, I was even forced to this
bold address to thee by the disposition of thy people, who are
discontented at Absalom's perpetual banishment, lest, if Absalom by his
father-in-law's assistance invade the land, the people who have a great
kindness for him, and think he is very hard used, should take up
arms.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p9">16. Hear - For I know the king is so wise and just, that
I assure myself of audience and acceptation. Deliver - To grant my
request concerning my son, and consequently the peoples petition
concerning Absalom. My son - Implying that her life was bound up in the
life of her son, and that she could not outlive his death; (and
supposing that it might be David's case also, and would therefore touch
him in a tender part, though it were not proper to say it expressly:)
and thereby suggesting, that the safety and comfort of the people of
Israel, depended upon Absalom's restitution. Inheritance - That is, out
of that land which God gave to his people to be their inheritance, and
in which alone God hath settled the place of his presence and worship:
whereby she intimates the danger of Absalom's living in a state of
separation from God, and his house, amongst idolaters.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p10">17. Angel - In wisdom, and justice, and goodness.
Therefore - Because thou art so wise and gracious to those who in strict
justice deserve punishment, God will own and stand by thee in this thy
act of grace: or God will prosper thee in thy enterprizes.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p11">19. Of Joab - Hast thou not said and done this by Joab's
direction. Said - It is even so, thou hast discovered the truth. These
words - As to the substance of them, but not as to all the expressions;
for these were to be varied as the king's answer gave occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p12">20. To fetch - That is, to propose his, and the peoples
desire of Absalom's restitution in this parabolical manner. In the earth
- Or, in this land, in all thy kingdom; all the counsels and devices of
thy subjects.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p13">22. Fulfilled - But it seems David had no power to
dispense with God's laws, nor to spare any whom God appointed him to
destroy: for the laws of God bound the kings and rulers, as well as the
people of Israel. How justly did God make this man, whom he had so
sinfully spared, a scourge to him?</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p14">24. Let him turn - Lest whilst be shewed some mercy to
Absalom, he should seem to approve of his sin. Likewise by this means
Absalom might be drawn to a more thorough humiliation and
repentance.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p15">25. Beauty - This is noted as the occasion of his pride,
and of the people's affection to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p16">26. Weighed - Others understand this not of the weight,
but of the price of his hair.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p17">27. Sons - All which died not long after they were born,
as may be gathered from chap. xviii, 18, where it is said, that Absalom
had no son.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p18">32. Kill me - For it is better for me to die, than to
want the sight and favour of my dear father. Thus he insinuates himself
into his father's affections, by pretending such respect and love to him
It seems that by this time Absalom having so far recovered his father's
favour, began to grow upon him, and take so much confidence as to stand
upon his own justification, as if what he had done, had been no
iniquity, at least not such as to deserve death. See how easily wise
parents may be imposed on by their children, when they are blindly fond
of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xv.ii-p19">33. Kissed - Did the bowels of a father prevail to
reconcile him to an impenitent son? And shall penitent sinners question
the compassion of him who is the Father of mercy? If Ephraim bemoan
himself, God soon bemoans him, with all the expressions of fatherly
tenderness. He is a dear son, a pleasant child.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="61.87%" prev="ii.xi.xv.ii" next="ii.xi.xvi.i" id="ii.xi.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XV" id="ii.xi.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="61.87%" prev="ii.xi.xvi" next="ii.xi.xvi.ii" id="ii.xi.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.i-p1">Absalom steals the hearts of the people, ver. 1-6. He
conspires against David, ver. 7-12. David flies from Jerusalem, ver.
13-18. He confers with Ittai, and passes over Kidron, ver. 19- 23. Sends
back Zadok with the ark, ver. 24-29. His prayer on this occasion, ver.
30, 31. He concerts with Hushai, ver. 32-37.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="61.87%" prev="ii.xi.xvi.i" next="ii.xi.xvii" id="ii.xi.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p1">1. Prepared - As being the king's eldest son, now Amnon
was dead; for Chileab, who was his eldest brother, chap. iii, 3, was
either dead, or incapable of the government. And this course he knew
would draw the eyes of the people to him, and make them conclude that
David intended him for his successor.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p2">2. Early - Thereby making a shew of solicitude for the
good of the public, and of every private person. Called him - Preventing
him with the offers of his assistance. And as if he were ready to make
particular enquiry into the state of his cause.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p3">3. See - Upon some very slight hearing of their cause, he
approved it, that he might oblige all. No man - None such as will do
thee justice. The other sons and relations of the king, and the rest of
the Judges and rulers under him and them, are wholly corrupted; or, at
least not careful and diligent as they should be: and my father being
grown in years, is negligent of publick affairs. It is the way of
turbulent, aspiring men, to reproach the government they are under. Even
David himself, the best of kings, could not escape the worst of
censures.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p4">7. After forty years - From the change of the government,
into a monarchy, which was about ten years before David began to reign.
So this fell out about the thirtieth year of his reign.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p5">9. Hebron - This place he chose as being an eminent city,
and next to Jerusalem, the chief of the tribe of Judah, and the place
where his father began his kingdom, which he took for a good omen. And
where it is probable he had secured many friends. It was also at a
convenient distance from Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p6">11. Called - Such as Absalom had picked out as fit for
his purpose; such as were of some reputation with the king and people,
which would give a countenance to his undertaking, and give occasion to
people at first to think that this was done by his father's consent, as
being now aged, and infirm, and willing to resign the kingdom to him. It
is no new thing, for good men to be made use of by designing men to put
a colour upon ill practices.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p7">12. Sacrifices - Which he did not in devotion to God; but
merely that upon this pretense he might call great numbers of people
together.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p8">14. Let us flee - For though the fort of Zion was strong,
and he might have defended himself there; yet he had not laid in
provisions for a long siege; and, if he had been once besieged there,
Absalom would have got speedy possession of his whole kingdom; whereas
if he marched abroad, he might raise a considerable army for his
defense. Besides, the greatest part of Jerusalem could not be well
defended against him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p9">16. After him - Or, on foot, which the king chose to do,
to humble himself under the hand of God; to encourage his companions in
this hard and comfortless march; and to move compassion in his people
towards him. Concubines - For he supposed that their sex would protect
them, and their relation to David would gain them some respect, or at
least, safety from his son.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p10">17. Far off - At some convenient distance, tho' not very
far.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p11">18. Gittites - Or rather strangers, as Ittai their head
is called, ver. 19, and they are called his brethren, ver. 20. Probably
they were Philistines by birth, born in the city or territory of Gath,
as the following words imply, who by David's counsel, and example, were
won to embrace the true religion, and had given good proof of their
military skill, and valour, and fidelity to the king.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p12">19. Thy place - To Jerusalem, where thy settled abode now
is. The king - With Absalom who is now made king. An exile - Not much
concerned in our affairs, and therefore not fit to be involved in our
troubles.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p13">20. Brethren - Thy countrymen the Gittites, ver. 18.
Mercy, &amp;c. - Since I am now unable to recompense thy kindness and
fidelity to me, my hearty prayer to God is, that he would shew to thee
his mercy, in blessing thee with all sorts of blessings, and his
faithfulness in making good all these promises which he had made, not to
Israelites only, but to all true hearted proselytes, such as thou
art.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p14">21. Will thy servant be - He is a friend indeed, who
loves at all times, and will cleave to us in adversity. Thus should we
cleave to the Son of David, that neither life, nor death may separate us
from his love.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p15">22. Little ones - For being so deeply engaged for David,
he durst not leave his little ones to Absalom's mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p16">23. Kidron - Or, Cedron, which was near Jerusalem. The
very same brook that Christ passed over when he entered upon his
sufferings, <scripRef passage="John xviii. 1" id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p16.1" parsed="|John|18|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:John.18.1">John xviii, 1</scripRef>. Wilderness - Which was between Jerusalem and Jericho.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p17">24. Went up - From the ark to the city, which was on
higher ground, that so he being high-priest, might use his authority
with the people, to persuade them to do their duty; and there he staid
until all those whom he could persuade were gone forth.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p18">25. Carry back - Out of care and reverence to the ark,
which though it might be carried our to a certain place; yet he might
justly think unfit to carry it from place to place he knew not whither,
and out of respect to the priests, whom, by this means, he thought he
should expose to the rage of Absalom, as he had before exposed them to
Saul's fury. Habitation - That is, the tabernacle which David had lately
built for it, chap. vi, 17, in which the ark, and God, by means hereof,
ordinarily dwelt.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p19">26. Let him do - That we may not complain of what is, let
us see God's hand in all events. And that we may not be afraid of what
shall be, let us see all events in God's hand.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p20">27. A seer - A seeing, discerning, or observing man: for
so the Hebrew verb raah is often used. And this suits well with David's
mind: Thou art a wise man, and therefore fit to manage this great
business, which requires prudence and secrecy.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p21">30. Barefoot - In testimony of his deep sorrow, and
humiliation and shame for his sins.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p22">34. And say - That is, as faithful to thee, as I have
been to thy father. David's suggesting this crafty counsel must be
reckoned amongst his sins. Nevertheless God was pleased to direct this
evil advice to a good end.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p23">36. There - Not in Jerusalem, but in a place near it, to
which they could easily send upon occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvi.ii-p24">37. Absalom came, &amp;c. - How soon do royal cities and
royal palaces change their masters? But we look for a kingdom which
cannot be moved.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="61.98%" prev="ii.xi.xvi.ii" next="ii.xi.xvii.i" id="ii.xi.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XVI" id="ii.xi.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="61.98%" prev="ii.xi.xvii" next="ii.xi.xvii.ii" id="ii.xi.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.i-p1">David is deceived by Ziba, ver. 1-4. And cursed by
Shemei, ver. 5-14. Absalom receives Hushai, ver. 15-19. Lies with his
father's concubines, ver. 20-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="61.99%" prev="ii.xi.xvii.i" next="ii.xi.xviii" id="ii.xi.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p1">1. Bottle - A large bottle, or vessel proportionable to
the other provisions.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p2">4. Behold - A rash sentence, and unrighteous to condemn a
man unheard, upon the single testimony of his accuser, and servant. Find
grace - Thy favour is more to me, than this gift; which, as a token of
thy favour, I accept with all thankfulness.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p3">8. Of Saul - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p4">1. The blood of Abner and Ishbosheth; which
he imputes to David, as if they had been killed by David's contrivance:
or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p5">2. the death of Saul's seven sons, chap.
xxi, 8, which, though related after this, seems to have been done
before. Art taken - The same mischief thou didst bring upon others, is
now returned upon thy own head.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p6">10. What have I, &amp;e. - In this matter I ask not your
advice, nor will I follow it; nor do I desire you should at all concern
yourselves in it. The Lord - God did not put any wickedness into
Shimei's heart, for he had of himself an heart full of malignity against
David; but only left him to his own wickedness; and brought David into
so distressed a condition, that he might seem a proper object of his
scorn. And this is ground enough for this expression, the Lord said, not
by the word of his precept, but by the word of his providence, in
respect whereof he is said to command the ravens, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xvii. 4" id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|1Kgs|17|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.17.4">1 Kings xvii, 4</scripRef>, and to send forth his word to senseless creatures, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm
1</scripRef>xlvii, 15, 18. Who shall reproach God's providence for permitting this?
Or, who shall restrain him from executing his just judgment against
me?</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p7">11. My life - Which is a greater mischief, than to
reproach me with words. Benjamites - Of that tribe and family from which
God hast taken away the kingdom, and given it to me. Let him - Do not
now hinder him violently from it, nor punish him for it. It is meet I
should bear the indignation of the Lord, and submit to his pleasure.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p8">14. Came - To the city of Bahurim.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p9">17. Is this - Doth this action answer that profession of
friendship which thou hast hitherto made to him? He speaks thus only to
try him. And he saith, thy friend, by way of reflection upon David; as
one who was a friend to Hushai, and to strangers but not to his own son,
whom, by his severity he provoked to this course; and therefore he doth
not vouchsafe to call him his father.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p10">21. Go - This counsel he gave, partly to revenge the
injury done to Bathsheba, the daughter of Eliam, chap. xi, 3, who was
the son of Ahithophel, chap. xxiii, 34, and principally for his own, and
the people's safety, that the breach between David and Absalom might be
irreparable. For this would provoke David in the highest degree and cut
of all hope of reconciliation, which otherwise might have been expected
by some treaty between Absalom and his tender-hearted father. But in
that case his followers, and especially Ahithophel, had been left to
David's mercy, and therefore obliged to prosecute the war with all
vigour, and to abandon all thoughts of peace: as knowing that his
father, though be might dissemble, yet would never forgive so foul a
crime. Be strong - They will fight with greater courage and resolution,
when they are freed from the fear of thy reconciliation, which otherwise
would make their hearts faint, and hands slack in thy cause. But by this
we may see the character of Absalom's party, and how abominably wicked
they were, whom such a scandalous action tied the faster to him. And we
may farther learn, how corrupt the body of the people was, how ripe for
that judgment which is now hastening to them.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p11">22. The top - Of the king's palace, the very place from
whence David had gazed upon Bathsheba, chap. xi, 2, so that his sin was
legible in the very place of his punishment. Went in - To one, or some
of them. And by so doing did farther make claim to the kingdom; and, as
it were, take possession of it. It being usual in the eastern countries
to account the wives and concubines of the late king, to belong of right
to the successor. Israel - Who saw him go into the tent; and thence
concluded, that he lay with them, as he had designed to do. God had
threatened by Nathan, that for his defiling Bathsheba, David's own wives
should be defiled in the face of the sun. This is now fulfilled: the
Lord is righteous; and no word of his shall fall to the ground.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xvii.ii-p12">23. The counsel, &amp;c. - It was received by the people
with equal veneration, and was usually attended with as certain success.
Which is mentioned as the reason why a counsel which had so ill a face,
should meet with such general approbation.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="62.07%" prev="ii.xi.xvii.ii" next="ii.xi.xviii.i" id="ii.xi.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XVII" id="ii.xi.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="62.07%" prev="ii.xi.xviii" next="ii.xi.xviii.ii" id="ii.xi.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.i-p1">Ahithophel advises Absalom to dispatch, ver. 1-4 Hushai
advises deliberation, and his advice is received, ver. 5-14.
Intelligence is sent to David, ver. 15-21. David passes over Jordan,
ver. 22. Ahithophel hangs himself, ver. 23. Absalom pursues David, ver.
24-26. David is supplied with necessaries, ver. 27-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="62.07%" prev="ii.xi.xviii.i" next="ii.xi.xix" id="ii.xi.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p1">2. And I will, &amp;c. - That such a wretch as Absalom
should aim at his father's throat is not strange. But that the body of
the people, to whom David had been so great a blessing, should join with
him in it, is amazing. But the finger of God was in it. Let not the best
of parents, or the best of princes think it strange, if they are injured
by those who should be their support and joy, when they (like David)
have provoked God to turn against them.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p2">5. Call Hushai - A wonderful effect of Divine Providence,
influencing his heart, that he could not rest in Ahithophel's counsel,
though it was so evidently wise, and approved by the general consent of
his whole party; and that he should desire Hushai's advice, though
neither his reputation for wisdom was equal to Ahithophel's, nor had he
yet given anyone proof of his fidelity to Absalom. But there is no
contending with that God who can arm a man against himself, and destroy
him by his own mistakes and passions.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p3">9. Pit - Having been often accustomed to that course, and
well acquainted with in all hiding-places from Saul's time. In one of
them, unknown to us, he will lurk with some of his chosen men, and lie
in ambush for us; and, when they see a fit opportunity, they will
suddenly come forth and surprize some of our men, when they least expect
it, and probably at first put them to flight. Some - Namely, of
Absalom's men sent against David. At the first - Implying, that their
good success at first would mightily animate David's men to proceed
vigourously in the fight, and intimidate Absalom's army, and
consequently would be both a presage and an occasion of their total
defeat.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p4">11. I counsel - His pretense was, that they might make
sure, though slow work: his design was to gain David time, that he might
increase his army, and make better provision for the battle; and that
the present heat of the people might be cooled, and they might bethink
themselves of their duty, and return to their allegiance. Thou - For thy
presence will put life and courage into thy soldiers, who will be
ambitious to shew their skill and courage in defending thy person, when
they know that all their actions are observed by him who hath the
distribution of rewards and punishments in his hands. Besides, the glory
of the victory will be wholly thine, which now Ahithophel seeks to get
to himself.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p5">12. As dew - That is, plenteously, suddenly,
irresistibly, and on all sides; for so the dew falls.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p6">13. Bring ropes - It is an hyperbolical expression,
suited to the vain-glorious temper of this insolent young man: implying,
that they would do so if they could not destroy him another way: or,
that they should be enough to do so, if there were occasion. River -
Adjoining to the city; it being usual to build cities near some river,
both for defense, and for other accommodations.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p7">14. Absalom and all, &amp;c. - Be it observed, to the
comfort of all that fear God, he turns all mans hearts as the rivers of
water. He stands in the congregation of the mighty, has an over-ruling
hand in all counsels, and a negative voice in all resolves, and laughs
at mens projects against his children.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p8">16. Lodge not - Lest the king's and people's mind's
change, and Ahithophel persuade the king to pursue you speedily.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p9">17. Enrogel - Or, the fullers well. A place near
Jerusalem, <scripRef passage="Josh. xv. 7" id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Josh|15|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.15.7">Josh.
xv, 7</scripRef>; xviii, 16. Wench - Pretending to go thither to wash some
cloaths, or to draw water.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p10">19. Spread corn - Under pretense of drying it by the sun:
which shews it was summer-time.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p11">20. Over the brook of water - That is, over Jordan. This
was a manifest lie.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p12">23. Hanged himself - See here contempt poured upon the
wisdom of man! He that was more renowned for policy than ever any man
was, played the fool with himself more than ever any man did. See
likewise honour done to the justice of God! The wicked is snared in the
work of his own hands.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p13">24. Passed - Not speedily, but when all the men of Israel
were gathered together according to Hushai's counsel.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p14">25. Nahash - Nahash is the name of Jesse's wife, by whom
he had this Abigail, as he had Zeruiah by another wife; so they were
sisters by the father, but not by the mother.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p15">27. Shobi - Who, as it may seem, disliked and disowned
that barbarous action to the ambassadors; and therefore, when the rest
were destroyed, was left king or governor of the residue of the
Ammonites. Machir - See above chap. ix, 4.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xviii.ii-p16">29. In - Having been in the wilderness. Thus God
sometimes makes up to his people that comfort from strangers, which they
are disappointed of in their own families.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="62.15%" prev="ii.xi.xviii.ii" next="ii.xi.xix.i" id="ii.xi.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XVIII" id="ii.xi.xix-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="62.15%" prev="ii.xi.xix" next="ii.xi.xix.ii" id="ii.xi.xix.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xix.i-p1">David prepares to engage the rebels, ver. 1-5. The total
defeat of Absalom, ver. 6-8. His death and burial, ver. 9-18. The news
brought to David, ver. 19-32. His lamentation over Absalom, ver. 33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="62.16%" prev="ii.xi.xix.i" next="ii.xi.xx" id="ii.xi.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xix.ii-p1">5. Deal gently - If you conquer (which be presaged they
would by God's gracious answer to his prayer for the turning of
Ahithophel's counsel into foolishness,) take him prisoner, but do not
kill him. Which desire proceeded, from his great indulgence towards his
children: from his consciousness that he himself was the meritorious
cause of this rebellion, Absalom being given up to it for the punishment
of David's sins; from the consideration of his youth, which commonly
makes men foolish, and subject to ill counsels: and from his piety,
being loth that he should be cut off in the act of his sin without any
space for repentance. But "what means, says Bp. Hall, this ill-placed
mercy? Deal gently with a traitor? Of all traitors with a son? And all
this for thy sake, whose crown, whose blood he hunts after? Even in the
holiest parents nature may be guilty of an injurious tenderness. But was
not this done in type of that unmeasurable mercy, of the true King of
Israel, who prayed for his murderers, Father, forgive them! Deal gently
with them for my sake!" Yea, when God sends an affliction to correct his
children, it is with this charge, deal gently with them for my sake: for
he knows our frame.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xix.ii-p2">8. The wood - More people died in the wood, either
through hunger, and thirst, and weariness: or, by the wild beasts,
whereof great numbers were there, which, though they were driven away
from the place of the main battle, yet might easily meet with them when
they fled several ways: or, by falling into ditches and pits, which were
in that place, ver. 17, and probably were covered with grass or wood, so
that they could not see them till they fell into them: and especially by
David's men, who pursued them, and killed them in the wood: and the wood
is rightly said to have devoured them, because it gave the occasion to
their destruction, inasmuch as the trees, and ditches, and pits,
entangled them, and stopped their flight, and made them an easy prey to
David's men, who followed them, and slew them in the pursuit. The sword
- In the main battle: the sword being put for the battle, by a common
figure.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xix.ii-p3">9. The servants of David - Who, according to David's
command, spared him, and gave him an opportunity to escape. His head -
In which probably he was entangled by the hair of the head, which being
very long and thick, might easily catch hold of a bough, especially when
the great God directed it. Either he wore no helmet, or he had thrown it
away as well as his other arms, to hasten his flight. Thus the matter of
his pride was the instrument of his ruin.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xix.ii-p4">15. Slew him - The darts did not dispatch him, and
therefore they smote him again, and killed him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xix.ii-p5">18. A pillar - To preserve his name; whereas it had been
more for his honour if his name had been buried in perpetual
oblivion.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xix.ii-p6">24. Gates - For the gates of the cities then were, as now
they are, large and thick; and for the greater security, had two gates,
one more outward, the other inward. Here he sat, that he might hear
tidings when any came into the city.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xix.ii-p7">33. Over the gate - Retiring himself from all men and
business, that he might wholly give up himself to lamentation. My son -
This he might speak from a deep sense of his eternal state, because he
died in his sins, and because David himself had by his own sins been the
occasion of his death. But it seems rather to be the effect of strong
passion, causing him to speak unadvisedly with his lips.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="62.22%" prev="ii.xi.xix.ii" next="ii.xi.xx.i" id="ii.xi.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XIX" id="ii.xi.xx-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="62.22%" prev="ii.xi.xx" next="ii.xi.xx.ii" id="ii.xi.xx.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xx.i-p1">Joab prevails on David to refrain, ver. 1-8. He is
brought back to his kingdom by the men of Judah, ver. 9-15. Pardons
Shimei, ver. 16-23. Restores to Mephibosheth his estate, ver. 24- 30.
Barzillai is dismissed, and his son taken into David's service, ver.
31-40. The Israelites expostulate with the men of Judah, ver. 41-43.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="62.22%" prev="ii.xi.xx.i" next="ii.xi.xxi" id="ii.xi.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p1">3. By stealth - Not openly and triumphantly, as
conquerors use to do; but secretly, as if they were afraid and ashamed,
lest David should see them, and look upon them with an evil eye, as
those that had an hand in killing of his beloved son.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p2">5. Hast shamed - By disappointing their just hopes of
praises and rewards, and by requiting them with contempt and tacit
rebukes.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p3">6. Pleased thee - This is not be understood as exactly
true; but David's carriage gave too much colour to such a suggestion;
and such sharpness of speech was in a manner necessary to awaken the
king out of his lethargy, and to preserve him from the impendent
mischiefs.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p4">9. At strife - Quarrelling one with another as the
authors or abettors of this shameful rebellion, and discoursing
privately and publickly of David's high merits, which God, being now
reconciled to David, brings afresh to their memories.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p5">10. Now therefore - The people of Israel speak thus to
the elders of Israel, as appears by comparing this verse with the next.
Seeing their designs for Absalom disappointed, they now repented of that
undertaking, and were willing to testify so much by their forwardness to
bring back David, and re-establish him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p6">11. Judah - Who being the abettors of Absalom's
rebellion, despaired of pardon, and therefore were backward to promote
the king's restoration. His house - Even to Mahanaim, where now the
king's house and family is.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p7">13. Of Joab - Who, besides his other crimes, had lately
exasperated the king by his murder of Absalom, contrary to David's
express command. And therefore the king having now the opportunity of
another person who had a greater interest than Joab, gladly complies
with it, that so he might both chastise Joab for his faults, and rescue
himself from the bondage in which Joab had hitherto held him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p8">14. He bowed - David by this prudent and kind message and
his free offer of pardon.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p9">17. With him - Whom he brought, partly to shew his
interest in the people, and partly, as intercessors on his behalf, and
as witnesses of David's clemency or severity, that in him they might see
what the rest of them might expect. Ziba - Who, being conscious of his
former abuse of David, and of his master Mephibosheth, which he knew the
king would understand, designed to sweeten David's spirit towards him,
by forwardness in meeting him.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p10">20. House of Joseph - The house of Joseph is here put for
all the tribes, except Judah, which are fitly distinguished from Judah,
because the rights of the first-born were divided between Judah and
Joseph, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. v. 2" id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p10.1" parsed="|1Chr|5|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.5.2">1 Chron. v, 2</scripRef>. And though Benjamin, after the division of the kingdoms was
fitly joined with Judah, because then they adhered to that tribe; yet
before that time it was joined with Joseph, because they marched under
the standard of the house of Joseph, or of Ephraim, <scripRef passage="Num. x. 22, 23, 24" id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p10.2" parsed="|Num|10|22|10|24" osisRef="Bible:Num.10.22-Num.10.24">Num. x, 22, 23, 24</scripRef>. Whence it is, that Ephraim, Benjamin, and Manasseh, are put
together, <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxx. 2" id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p10.3" parsed="|Ps|80|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.80.2">Psalm
lxxx, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p11">22. Adversaries - That is, that you put me upon things
unfit for me to do, and contrary to my interest; for it was David's
interest at this time to appease the people, and reconcile them to him,
and not to give them any new distaste by acts of severity: for this
would make others jealous, that he would watch an opportunity to be
revenged on them. King - Is not my kingdom, which was in a manner wholly
lost, just now restored and assured to me? And when God hath been so
merciful to me in forgiving my sin, shall I shew myself revengeful to
Shemei? Shall I sully the publick joy and glory of this day, with an act
of such severity? Or, shall I alienate the hearts of my people from me,
now they are returning to me?</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p12">24. The son - That is, the grandson, chap. vi, 3, 6. His
feet - By washing his feet, which was usual in those hot climates, and
very refreshing; and therefore now neglected, as becoming a mourner.
Beard - But suffered it to grow very long, and disorderly, as was usual
with persons in a forlorn, or mournful state. Clothes - His linen
cloathes. This and the former were signs, that he was a true and
obstinate mourner, and evidences of the falsehood of Ziba's relation
concerning him, chap. xvi, 3.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p13">25. Jerusalem - Probably he had continued near Jerusalem,
because he could not go to meet him, as others did.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p14">26. Deceived me - By carrying away the ass which I bid
him saddle for me.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p15">27. Angel - To distinguish between true reports and
calumnies; See note on "chap. xiv, 20".</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p16">28. Before - Before thy tribunal: we were all at thy
mercy: not my estate only but my life also was in thy power, if thou
hadst dealt with rigor, and as earthly kings use to do with their
predecessor's and enemies children. To cry - For the vindication of mine
honour, and the restitution of my estate.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p17">29. Divide - The land shall be divided between thee and
him, as it was by my first order, chap. ix, 10, he and his sons managing
it, and supporting themselves out of it, as they did before, and giving
the rest of the profits thereof to thee.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p18">35. I am, &amp;c. - My senses are grown dull, and
incapable of relishing the pleasures of a court. I am past taking
pleasures in delicious tastes, or sweet musick, and other such delights.
I am through age both useless and burdensome to others, and therefore
most improper for a court life.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p19">37. That I may die in mine own city - That my bones may
with little ado, be carried to the place of their rest. The grave is
ready for me: let me go and get ready for it, go and die in my nest.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p20">40. Half - Whereas the men of Judah came entirely and
unanimously to the king, the Israelites of the other tribe came in but
slowly, and by halves, as being no less guilty of the rebellion, than
the tribe of Judah; but not encouraged to come in by such a gracious
message as they were. And this is here mentioned as the occasion both of
the contention here following, and of the sedition, chap. xx, 1-22.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p21">41. All - Such as were present. Stolen - That is,
conveyed thee over Jordan hastily, not expecting our concurrence.
David's men - All thy officers, guards, and soldiers. This is mentioned
as an aggravation of their fault, that they did not only carry the king
over Jordan, but all his men too, without asking their advice.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p22">42. Of kin - Of the same tribe with us, and therefore
both oweth the more respect to us, and might expect more respect from
us. Gifts - We have neither sought nor gained any advantage to ourselves
hereby, but only discharged our duty to the king, and used all
expedition in bringing him back, which you also should have done, and
not have come in by halves, and so coldly as you have done.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xx.ii-p23">43. Ten - They say but ten, though strictly there were
eleven; either, because they accounted Joseph (which comprehends both
Ephraim and Manasseh under it) for one tribe, or because Simeon, whose
lot lay within the tribe of Judah, were joined with them in this action.
More right - As in the general we have more right in the king and
kingdom; so particularly, we have more right in David than you, because
you were the first beginners, and the most zealous promoters of this
rebellion; howsoever, as he is king, we justly claim a greater interest
in him, than you; inasmuch as we are the far greatest part of his
subjects. Fiercer - Instead of mollifying them with gentle words, they
answered them with greater fierceness so that David durst not interpose
in the matter.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="62.35%" prev="ii.xi.xx.ii" next="ii.xi.xxi.i" id="ii.xi.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XX" id="ii.xi.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="62.35%" prev="ii.xi.xxi" next="ii.xi.xxi.ii" id="ii.xi.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.i-p1">A new rebellion raised by Sheba, ver. 1, 2. David
confines his ten concubines for life, ver. 3. Joab murders Amasa, ver.
4-12. Pursues Sheba to Abel, ver. 13-15. He is delivered up, ver. 16-22.
David's great officers, ver. 23-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="62.36%" prev="ii.xi.xxi.i" next="ii.xi.xxii" id="ii.xi.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p1">1. Happened - His presence was casual in itself, though
ordered by God's providence. No part - The tribe of Judah have
monopolized the king to themselves, and will not allow us any share in
him; let them therefore enjoy him alone, and let us seek out a new king.
The son of Jesse - An expression of contempt, implying that he was no
more to be owned as their king, but as a private person, as the son of
Jesse. To his tents - Let us all desist from this unthankful office, of
bringing the king back, and go each to our homes, that we may consider,
and then meet together to chuse a new king.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p2">2. Every man - That is, the generality of those
Israelites who were present.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p3">5. Tarried - Either, because the people being wearied out
by the late war, were not forward to engage in another: or because the
soldiers had more affection to Joab, than to their new general.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p4">6. Abishai - Not to Joab; lest by this means he should
recover his place, and Amasa be discontented, and David's fidelity in
making good his promise to Amasa be questioned.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p5">7. Joab's men - The remainders of Joab's army who were
there present, with whom also Joab might go as a reformade, watching an
opportunity to do what he designed.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p6">8. Amasa went - Having gathered some forces, and given
due orders for the rest to follow him, he returned to Jerusalem, and by
the king's command went after those mentioned ver. 7, and being come up
to them at the place where they waited for him, he put himself in the
head of Joab's men, and the Cherethites and the Pelethites, and such as
he had brought along with him, and marched before them as their general.
Girded - After the manner of travelers and soldiers. Went forth - To
meet and salute Amasa, who was coming towards him to do him honour. It
fell - Things having (it is likely) been so contrived by Joab, that upon
the least motion of his body, his sword should drop out, and he might
take it up without raising Amasa's suspicion.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p7">9. Beard - As the manner of ancient times was, when they
saluted one another.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p8">10. The sword - Which falling out, as it seemed,
casually, he supposed that Joab intended only to put it into its
scabbard, and therefore took no care to defend himself against the
stroke. So Joab - Who now boldly resumed his former place, and marched
in the head of the army. It is not strange, that Amasa's soldiers did
not fight to revenge his death; partly, because not many of them were
yet come up, as the following verses shew; and partly, because Joab's
interest and authority with the military-men was very great; especially,
with David's guards, who were here present, and who had no kindness for
Amasa, as having been the general of the rebellious army; and, as they
might think, not fit to be put into a place of so great trust.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p9">11. One - Left there on purpose to deliver the following
message. favoureth Joab - He that would have Joab to be general, rather
than such a perfidious rebel as Amasa. For David - He that wisheth David
good success against Sheba, and against all rebels.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p10">12. Stood still - Wondering at the spectacle, and
enquiring into the author and occasion of it. Removed - Perceiving, that
it both incensed them against Joab and hindered the king's service. Cast
a cloth upon him - But the covering of blood with a cloth cannot stop
its cry to God for vengeance.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p11">14. He - Sheba, who marched from tribe to tribe to stir
them up to sedition. Abel - Unto Abel-beth-maachah, as this place is
called here in the Hebrew text, ver. 15, to distinguish it from other
Abels; and to signify, that this was that Abel which was in the northern
border of Canaan towards that part of Syria called Maachah, chap. x, 8.
Berites - Such as lived in the city, or territory of Beeroth of
Benjamin, <scripRef passage="Josh. xviii. 25" id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Josh|18|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.18.25">Josh. xviii, 25</scripRef>, who being of the same tribe, if not city with Sheba,
adhered to him, and followed him through all the tribes of Israel. They
- The tribes of Israel; that is, a considerable number of them; as might
well be expected, when the discontents were so high and general.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p12">15. They - That is, Joab and his army. A bank - From
whence they might either batter the wall, or shoot at those who defended
it. It stood - The bank stood in, or near to the trench, or the wall of
the city; so that the city was in great danger of being taken.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p13">16. Then cried a wise woman - It seems none of all the
men of Abel, offered to treat with Joab: no, not when they were reduced
to extremity: but one wise woman saved the city. Souls know no
difference of sex: many a manly heart is lodged in a female breast. Nor
is the treasure of wisdom the less valuable, for being lodged in the
weaker vessel.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p14">18. Ask counsel - This city which thou art about to
destroy, is no mean and contemptible one, but so honourable and
considerable for its wisdom, that when any differences arose among any
of the neighbours, they used proverbially to say, We will ask the
opinion and advice as the men of Abel about it, and we will stand to
their arbitration; and so all parties were satisfied, and disputes
ended.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p15">19. A mother - Great cities are commonly called mothers;
as lesser towns or villages subject to them, and depending upon them,
are called their daughters. Inheritance - That is, a considerable part
of, that land which God hath chosen for his particular possession. The
destruction which thou art about to bring upon us, is an injury to
Israel, and to the God of Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p16">21. Ephraim - Probably mount Ephraim was a place in
Benjamin so called, either because it was upon the borders of Ephraim or
for some notable action or event of the Ephraimites in that place. His
head - Which she undertook, because she knew the present temper of the
citizens, and soldiers too. And it is not unlikely, that this woman
might be a governness in that city. For though this office was commonly
performed by men; yet women were sometimes employed in the government:
as we see in Deborah, who judged Israel, <scripRef passage="Judg. iv. 4" id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p16.1" parsed="|Judg|4|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.4.4">Judg. iv, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p17">22. Wisdom - Prudently treated with them about it,
representing to them the certainty and nearness of their ruin, if they
did not speedily comply with her desires, and certain deliverance if
they did.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxi.ii-p18">23 Over all the host - The good success of this, and of
the former expedition, under the conduct of Joab, had so fixed his
interest in the army, and others of David's fastest friends, that the
king could not without danger displace him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="62.47%" prev="ii.xi.xxi.ii" next="ii.xi.xxii.i" id="ii.xi.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XXI" id="ii.xi.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="62.47%" prev="ii.xi.xxii" next="ii.xi.xxii.ii" id="ii.xi.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.i-p1">A famine, caused by Saul's killing the Gibeonites, ver.
1-3. Seven of his family put to death, ver. 4-9. Care taken of their
dead bodies, and of the bones of Saul, ver. 10-14. Battles with the
Philistines, ver. 15-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="62.47%" prev="ii.xi.xxii.i" next="ii.xi.xxiii" id="ii.xi.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p1">1. Then - The things related here and chap. xxiv, 1-25,
are by the best interpreters conceived to have been done long before
Absalom's rebellion. And this opinion is not without sufficient grounds:
first, this particle, then, is here explained, in the days, that is,
during the reign of David: which general words seem to be added as an
intimation that these things were not done after the next foregoing
passages, for then the sacred writer would rather have added, after
these things, as it is in many other places. Secondly, here are divers
passages which it seems improbable to ascribe to the last years of
David's reign: such as first, that Saul's sin against the Gibeonites
should so long remain unpunished. And indeed that this was done, and
Saul's seven sons hanged by David's order before that time, seems to be
intimated by that passage, chap. xvi, 8, where he is charged with the
blood of the house of Saul: for which there was not the least colour
'till this time. Secondly, that David should not remove the bones of
Saul and Jonathan to their proper place, 'till that time. Thirdly, that
the Philistines should wage war with David again and again, ver. 15,
&amp;c. so long after he had fully subdued them, chap. viii, 1, and that
David in his old age should attempt to fight with a Philistine giant, or
that his people should suffer him to do so. Fourthly, that David should
then have so vehement a desire to number his people, chap. xxiv, 1,
which being an act of youthful vanity, seems not at all to agree with
his old age, nor with that state of deep humiliation in which he then
was. And the reason why these matters are put here out of their proper
order, is plainly this, because David's sin being once related, it was
very convenient that David's punishments should immediately succeed:
this being very frequent in scripture-story, to put those things
together which belong to one matter, though they happened at several
times. He flew - Which was not only an act of cruelty, but also of
perfidiousness, because it was a public violation of that solemn oath
given to them by Joshua and the princes, in the name of all the
Israelites, of that and succeeding generations. "But why did not God
punish Saul whilst he was alive for this, but his children, and the
Israelites of this age?" First, God did severely punish Saul for this
and his other sins. Secondly, as God may justly inflict temporal
punishments upon any offender, either in his person, or in his
posterity, when he pleaseth; so it is meet he should take his own time
for it; and it is folly in us to quarrel with God for so doing. Thirdly,
the Israelites might sundry ways make themselves guilty of Saul's sin,
tho' it be not particularly mentioned, advising or encouraging him to
it; or, assisting him in the execution of it. And whereas many of the
people were probably innocent of that crime, yet they also were guilty
of many other sins, for which God might punish them, though he took this
occasion for it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p2">2. Sought - That is, he sought how he might cut them off
with some colour of justice, aggravating their faults, and punishing
them worse than they deserved; oppressing them with excessive labours,
and intending by degrees to wear them out.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p3">6. I will - Having doubtless consulted God in the matter;
who as he had before declared Saul's bloody house to be the causes of
this judgment, so now commanded that justice should be done upon it, and
that the remaining branches of it should be cut off; as sufficiently
appears from hence, that God was well pleased with the action; which he
would not have been, if David had done it without his command; for then
it had been a sinful action of David's, and contrary to a double law of
God, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxi. 23" id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Deut|21|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.21.23">Deut. xxi, 23</scripRef>; xxiv, 16.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p4">7. Spared - For the Gibeonites desiring only such a
number, it was at David's choice whom to spare. Of Jonathan - This is
added, to distinguish him from the other Mephibosheth, ver. 8.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p5">10. Spread it - As a tent to dwell in: being informed
that their bodies were not to be taken away speedily, as the course of
the law was in ordinary cases, but were to continue there until God was
intreated, and removed the present judgment. On the rock - In some
convenient place in a rock, near adjoining. Until water - Until they
were taken down: which was not to be done 'till God had given rain as a
sign of his favour, and a mean to remove the famine, which was caused by
the want of it. Thus she let the world know, that her sons died not for
any sin of their own, not as stubborn and rebellious sons, whose eye had
despised their mother: but for their father's sin, and therefore her
mind could not be alienated from them by their hard fate.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p6">11. David - Who heard it with so much approbation, that
he thought fit to imitate her piety, being by her example provoked to do
what hitherto he had neglected, to bestow an honourable interment on the
remains of Saul and Jonathan, and, with them, upon those that are now
put to death, that the honour done to them herein, might be some comfort
to this disconsolate widow.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p7">13. The bones - Having first burnt off the flesh which
remained upon them when they were taken down. Compare <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxxi. 10" id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|1Sam|31|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.31.10">1 Sam. xxxi,
10</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p8">14. After that - After those things were done which were
before related; that is, after they were hanged up: for by that God was
pacified, and not by their burial.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p9">18. After this - After the battle last mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxii.ii-p10">22. Born to the giant in Gath - These giants were
probably the remains of the sons of Anak, who, tho' long feared, fell at
last.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="62.57%" prev="ii.xi.xxii.ii" next="ii.xi.xxiii.i" id="ii.xi.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XXII" id="ii.xi.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="62.57%" prev="ii.xi.xxiii" next="ii.xi.xxiv" id="ii.xi.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xxiii.i-p1">This chapter is inserted among the Psalms, No. 18, with
some little variation. It is here as it was composed for his own closet;
there, as it was delivered to the chief musician for public service. The
inspired writer having largely related David's deliverances in this and
the foregoing book, thought fit to record this sacred poem, as a
memorial of all that had been before related</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="62.58%" prev="ii.xi.xxiii.i" next="ii.xi.xxiv.i" id="ii.xi.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Sam. XXIII" id="ii.xi.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|2Sam|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xi.xxiv-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="62.58%" prev="ii.xi.xxiv" next="ii.xi.xxiv.ii" id="ii.xi.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.i-p1">The last words of David, ver. 1-7. An account of his
mighty men, the first three, ver. 8-12. Two of the next three, ver.
13-23. And the thirty, ver. 24-39.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="62.58%" prev="ii.xi.xxiv.i" next="ii.xii" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p1">1. Last words - Not simply the last that he spoke, but
the last which he spake by the spirit of God, assisting and directing
him in an extraordinary manner. When we find death approaching, we
should endeavour both to honour God, and to profit others with our last
words. Let those who have had experience of God's goodness, and the
pleasantness of the ways of wisdom, when they come to finish their
course, leave a record of those experiences, and bear their testimony to
the truth of the promise. Raised - Advanced from an obscure estate, to
the kingdom. Whom, God singled out from all the families of Israel, and
anointed to be king. Psalmist - He who was eminent among the people of
God, for composing sweet and holy songs to the praise of God, and for
the use of his church in after ages: these seem not to be the words of
David, but of the sacred penman of this book.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p2">2. His word - The following words, and consequently the
other words and Psalms composed and uttered by me upon the like solemn
occasions, are not to be looked upon as human inventions, but both the
matter and the words of them are suggested by God's spirit, the great
teacher of the church.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p3">3. Rock - He who is the strength, and defense, and
protector of his people; which he manifests by directing kings and
rulers so to manage their power as may most conduce to their comfort and
benefit. Ruleth - Here are the two principal parts of a king's duty,
answerable to the two tables of God's law, justice towards men, and
piety towards God, both which he is to maintain and promote among his
people.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p4">4. Shall be - These words are a farther description of
the king's duty, which is not only to rule with justice and piety, but
also with sweetness, and gentleness, and condescension to the
infirmities of his people; to render his government as acceptable to
them, as is the sun-shine in a clear morning, or the tender grass which
springs out of the earth by the warm beams of the sun after the
rain.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p5">5. Altho' - Although God knows, that neither I, nor my
children have lived and ruled as we should have done, so justly, and in
the fear of the Lord; and therefore have not enjoyed that uninterrupted
prosperity which we might have enjoyed. Covenant - Notwithstanding all
our transgressions whereby we have broken covenant with God, yet God, to
whom all my sins were known, was graciously pleased to make a sure
covenant, to continue the kingdom to me, and to my seed forever, chap.
vii, 16, until the coming of the Messiah who is to be my son and
successor, and whose kingdom shall have no end. Ordered - Ordained in
all points by God's eternal counsel; and disposed by his wise and
powerful providence which will over-rule all things, even the sins of my
house so far, that although he punished them for their sins, yet he will
not utterly root them out, nor break his covenant made with me and mine.
Sure - Or, preserved, by God's power and faithfulness in the midst of
all oppositions. For this - Or, in this is, that is, it consists in, and
depends upon this covenant. Salvation - Both mine own eternal salvation,
and the preservation of the kingdom to me and mine. Tho' - Although God
as yet hath not made my house or family to grow; that is, to increase,
or to flourish with worldly glory as I expected; yet this is my comfort,
that God will inviolably keep this covenant. But this refers also to the
covenant of grace made with all believers. This is indeed an everlasting
covenant, from everlasting, in the contrivance of it, and to
everlasting, in the continuance and the consequence of it. It is
ordered, well ordered in all things; admirably well, to advance the
glory of God and the honour of the mediator, together with the holiness
and happiness of believers. It is sure, and therefore sure, because
well-ordered: the promised mercies are sure, on the performance of the
conditions. It is all our salvation: nothing but this will save us, and
this is sufficient. Therefore it should be all our desire. Let me have
an interest in this covenant, and I have enough, I desire no more.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p6">6. But - Having in the foregoing verses described the
nature, and stability of that kingdom which God had by a sure covenant
settled upon him and his seed; and especially, upon the Messiah, who was
to be one of his posterity; he now describes the nature and miserable
condition, of all the enemies of this holy and blessed kingdom. As
thorns - Which men do not use to handle, but thrust them away. And so
will God thrust away from himself, and from his people, and kingdom, all
those who shall either secretly or openly set themselves against it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p7">7. Fenced - He must arm himself with some iron weapon,
whereby he may cut them down; or, with the staff of a spear, or some
such thing, whereby he may thrust them away from himself, that they do
him no hurt. Burnt - Or, if they do not cut them down or thrust them
away they will burn and consume them. The place - Or, in their place,
where they grow or stand.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p8">8. These - But this catalogue, though placed here, was
taken long before, as is manifest from hence, that Asahel and Uriah are
named here. And whereas there are some difference between this list, and
that, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 10-47" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p8.1" parsed="|1Chr|11|10|11|47" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.10-1Chr.11.47">1 Chron. xi, 10-47</scripRef>, most of them are easily reconciled by these two
considerations;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p9">1. that nothing is more common than for one
person to have divers names.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p10">2. That as some of the worthies died, and
others came in their stead; this must needs cause some alteration in the
latter catalogue, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 10-47" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p10.1" parsed="|1Chr|11|10|11|47" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.10-1Chr.11.47">1 Chron. xi, 10-47</scripRef>, from this which was the former. Learn hence, how much
religion tends to inspire men with true courage. David both by his
writings and example greatly promoted piety among the grandees of the
kingdom. And when they became famous for piety, they became famous for
bravery. Adino - This was his proper name. Lift up - Which words are
fitly supplied out of <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 11" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p10.2" parsed="|1Chr|11|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.11">1 Chron. xi, 11</scripRef>, where they are expressed. One time - In one battle, which
though it be strange, yet cannot seem incredible, supposing him to be a
person of extraordinary strength and activity, and his enemies to be
discouraged, and fleeing away.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p11">9. Gone away - That is, fled away, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 13" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p11.1" parsed="|1Chr|11|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.13">1 Chron. xi, 13</scripRef>, being dismayed at the approach of their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p12">11. Lentiles - Or barley, as it is <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 13" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p12.1" parsed="|1Chr|11|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.13">1 Chron. xi, 13</scripRef>. For both might grow in the same field, in divers parts of
it. And this fact is ascribed to Eleazar,</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p13"><scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 12" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p13.1" parsed="|1Chr|11|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.12">1 Chron. xi, 12</scripRef>, but it is implied, that he had some partner or partners in
it; for it is there said, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 14" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p13.2" parsed="|1Chr|11|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.14">1 Chron. xi, 14</scripRef> they set themselves, &amp;c. So Eleazar might fight in that
part where the barley was and Shammah where the lentiles were.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p14">12. Lord wrought - How great soever the bravery of the
instruments is, the praise of the achievement is to be given to God.
These fought, but God wrought the victory.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p15">15. Said - Being hot and thirsty, he expresses how
acceptable a draught of that water would be to him; but was far from
desiring, or expecting that any of his men should hazard their lives to
procure it.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p16">16. Would not - Lest by gratifying himself upon such
terms, he should seem either to set too high a price upon the
satisfaction of his appetite, or too low a price upon the lives of his
soldiers. Poured it - As a kind of drink offering, and acknowledgment of
God's goodness in preserving the lives of his captains in so dangerous
an enterprize; and to shew, that he esteemed it as a sacred thing, which
it was not fit for him to drink.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p17">17. These three - Jointly: then two of them are mentioned
severally.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p18">19. Attained not - He fell short of them in strength and
valour.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p19">21. Pit - Where he put himself under a necessity, either
of killing, or being killed. Of snow - When lions are most fierce, both
from the sharpness of their appetite in cold seasons, and from want of
provisions.</p>

<p id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p20">25. Harodite - In <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 27" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p20.1" parsed="|1Chr|11|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.27">1 Chron. xi, 27</scripRef>, Shammoth the Harorite. Concerning which, and other changes
of the names, which will be observed, by comparing this catalogue with
that, it will be sufficient to suggest,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p21">1. that the same names of persons, or
places, are differently pronounced according to the different dialects
of divers places or ages.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p22">2. That one man had often two names.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p23">3. That David had more worthies than those
here mentioned; and as some of these were slain in the former part of
David's reign, as Asahel was; so others came up in their stead; and some
were added to this number, as appears from <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xi. 10-47" id="ii.xi.xxiv.ii-p23.1" parsed="|1Chr|11|10|11|47" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11.10-1Chr.11.47">1 Chron. xi, 10-47</scripRef>, where they are named, but not numbered, as they were here;
and where there is a greater number than is here expressed.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE FIRST BOOK OF KINGS" progress="62.73%" prev="ii.xi.xxiv.ii" next="ii.xii.i" id="ii.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1Kgs" id="ii.xii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.xii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE FIRST BOOK OF KINGS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to First Kings" progress="62.73%" prev="ii.xii" next="ii.xii.ii" id="ii.xii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.i-p1">THE two books of Samuel are an introduction to the two
books of Kings, as they relate the original of the royal government in
Saul, and of the royal family in David. These two books give us an
account of David's successor, Solomon, the division of his kingdom, and
the several kings of Israel and Judah, down to the captivity. And in
these special regard is had to the house of David, from which Christ
came. Some of his sons trod in his steps, and their reigns were usually
long, whereas those of the wicked kings were usually short: so that the
state of Judah (in Israel all the kings were wicked) was not so bad as
it would otherwise have been. In this first book we have, The death of
David, chap. 1, 2. The glorious reign of Solomon, chap. 3-10. His
defection, chap. 11. The division of the kingdom between Rehoboam and
Jeroboam, chap. 12-14. The reigns of Abijah and Asa over Judah, of Basha
and Omni over Israel, chap. 15, 16. The history of Elijah, chap. 17-19.
Ahab's success, wickedness, and death, chap. 20-22.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="62.75%" prev="ii.xii.i" next="ii.xii.ii.i" id="ii.xii.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings I" id="ii.xii.ii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="62.75%" prev="ii.xii.ii" next="ii.xii.ii.ii" id="ii.xii.ii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.ii.i-p1">David declines in health, ver. 1-4. Adonijah aspires to
the kingdom, ver. 5-10. Nathan and Bathsheba procure an order for the
succession of Solomon, ver. 11-31. The anointing of Solomon, and the
peoples joy, ver. 32-40. The dispersion of Adonijah's party, ver. 41-49.
Solomon dismisses Adonijah, ver. 50-53.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="62.75%" prev="ii.xii.ii.i" next="ii.xii.iii" id="ii.xii.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p1">1. Old - Being in the end of his seventieth year. No heat
- Which is not strange in a person who had been exercised with so many
hardships in war, and with such tormenting cares, and fears, and
sorrows, for his own sins (as divers of his Psalms witness) and for the
sins and miseries of his children and people. Besides, this might be
from the nature of his bodily distemper.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p2">2. Servants - His physicians. Virgin - Whose natural heat
is fresh and wholesome, and not impaired with bearing or breeding of
children. The same counsel doth Galen give for the cure of some cold and
dry distempers. Stand - That is, minister unto him, or wait upon him, in
his sickness, as occasion requires. Lie in his bosom - As his wife: for
that she was so, may appear by divers arguments. First, otherwise this
had been a wicked course; which therefore neither his servants durst
have prescribed, nor would David have used, especially being now in a
dying condition. Secondly, it appears from this phrase of lying in his
bosom, which is everywhere in scripture mentioned as the privilege of a
wife. Thirdly, this made Adonijah's crime in desiring her to wife, so
heinous in Solomon's account, because he saw, that by marrying the
king's wife he designed to revive his pretense to the kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p3">4. Knew her not - Which is mentioned to note the
continuance and progress of the king's malady.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p4">5. Then - Upon notice of the desperateness of the king's
disease, and the approach of his death. Exalted - Entertained high
thoughts and designs. I will - As the right of the kingdom is mine, ver.
6, so I will now take possession of it. Prepared - As Absalom had done
upon the like occasion, chap. xv, 1.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p5">6. Displeased him - This is noted as David's great error,
and the occasion of Adonijah's presumption. Saying - He neither
restrained him from, nor reproved him for his miscarriages: which David
well knew was a great sin. Goodly man - This was a second ground of his
confidence, because his great comeliness made him amiable in the peoples
eyes.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p6">7. They helped - Either because they thought the right of
the crown was his: or to secure and advance their own interest. It seems
God left them to themselves, to correct them for former miscarriages,
with a rod of their own making.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p7">10. Called not - Because he knew they favoured Solomon
his competitor.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p8">11. Nathan spake - Being prompted to it both by his piety
in fulfilling the will of God declared to him, concerning Solomon's
succession, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. vii. 13" id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|2Sam|7|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.7.13">2 Sam. vii, 13</scripRef>, and by his prudence, knowing that Adonijah hated him for
being the principal instrument of Solomon's advancement. Bathsheba - Who
being retired and private in her apartment, was ignorant of what was
done abroad: and, who was likely to be most zealous in the cause, and
most prevalent with David.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p9">26. But me - Whom he knew to be acquainted with thy mind,
and with the mind of God in this matter: and therefore his neglect of me
herein gives me cause to suspect that this is done without thy
privity.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p10">27. Shewed thy servant - Who, having been an instrument
in delivering God's message to thee concerning thy successor, might
reasonably expect that if the king had changed his mind, thou wouldest
have acquainted me with it, as being both a prophet os the Lord, and one
whom thou hast always found faithful to thee.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p11">28. Call Bathsheba - Who, upon Nathan's approach to the
king had modestly withdrawn.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p12">29. Out of all distress - The words contain a grateful
acknowledgement of the goodness of God to him, in bringing him safe
through the many difficulties, which had lain in his way, and which he
now mentions to the glory of God, (as Jacob when he lay a dying) thus
setting to his seal, from his own experience that the Lord redeemeth the
souls of his servants.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p13">31. Live forever - Though I desire thy oath may be kept,
and the right of succession confirmed to my son, yet I am far from
thirsting after thy death, and would rather rejoice, if it were possible
for thee to live and enjoy the crown forever. 33. My mule - As a token
that the royal dignity is transferred upon Solomon, and that by my
consent. Gihon - A river near Jerusalem, on the west side. Adonijah was
inaugurated on the east side. This place David chose, either, as remote
from Adonijah and his company, that so the people might be there without
fear of tumults or bloodshed; or, to shew that Solomon was chosen king
in opposition to Adonijah: or, because this was a place of great resort,
and fit to receive and display that numerous company, which he knew
would follow Solomon thither.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p14">34. Anoint - As they used to do where there was any thing
new or extraordinary in the succession. And this unction signified both
the designation of the persons to the office, and the gifts and graces
which were necessary for their office, and which, they, seeking them
sincerely from God, might expect to receive.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p15">35. My stead - My deputy and vice-king whilst I live, and
absolutely king when I die. And Judah - This is added, lest the men of
Judah, who were in a special manner invited by Adonijah, ver. 9, might
think themselves exempted from his jurisdiction.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p16">47. Bowed himself - Adoring God for this great mercy, and
thereby declaring his hearty consent to this action.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p17">48. Blessed, &amp;c. - It is a great satisfaction to good
men, when they are going out of the world, to see their children rising
up in their stead, to serve God and their generation: and especially to
see peace upon Israel, and the establishment of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p18">51. His servants - He owns Solomon as his king, and
himself as his servant and subject; and being sensible of his guilt, and
of the jealousy which kings have of their competitors, could not be
satisfied without Solomon's oath.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ii.ii-p19">53. Go to thine house - Lead a private life, without
noise and numerous attendants, and meddle not with the affairs of the
kingdom.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="62.86%" prev="ii.xii.ii.ii" next="ii.xii.iii.i" id="ii.xii.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings II" id="ii.xii.iii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="62.86%" prev="ii.xii.iii" next="ii.xii.iii.ii" id="ii.xii.iii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.iii.i-p1">David's charge to Solomon ver. 1-9. His death and burial,
with the beginning of Solomon's reign, ver. 10-12. He puts Adonijah to
death, ver. 13-25. Deposes Abiathar from the high-priesthood, ver. 26,
27. Puts Joab to death, ver. 28-35. Confines Shimei, to Jerusalem, ver.
36-38. Puts him to death, ver. 39-46.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="62.86%" prev="ii.xii.iii.i" next="ii.xii.iv" id="ii.xii.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p1">2. I go the way, &amp;c. - Even the sons and heirs of
heaven, must go the way of all the earth, of all who dwell thereon. But
they walk with pleasure in this way, thro' the valley of the shadow of
death. Prophets, yea kings must go this way to brighter light and honour
than prophecy or sovereignty. Be strong - For, to govern his people
according to the law of God, requires great fortitude, or strength of
mind. And a man - In manly wisdom, and courage, and constancy, though
thou art but young in years.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p2">3. The law - Which the prince was enjoined to transcribe
and read, <scripRef passage="Deut. xvii. 11" id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Deut|17|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.17.11">Deut. xvii, 11</scripRef>, that be might govern his own and his peoples actions by it.
Mayest profit - Or, behave thyself prudently. Hereby he intimates, that
religion is the truest reason of state, and that all true wisdom and
good success depend upon piety.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p3">4. Confirm his word - Fulfil his promise, the condition
upon which it was suspended, being performed.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p4">5. To me - That is, against me; in what he did against
Abner and Amasa: whose death was a great injury to David, as it was a
breach of his laws and peace; a contempt of his person and government; a
pernicious example to his subjects, and a great scandal to him, as if
Joab had been only David's instrument, to affect what he secretly
designed. And shed - He slew them as if they had been in the state of
war, when there was not only a cessation of arms, but also a treaty of
peace. Put the blood - This is added to note his impenitency, that
although by his perfidious manner of killing them when he pretended to
embrace them, he stained his own garments with their blood, yet he was
not ashamed of it, but gloried in it, and marched boldly along with the
army, with the same girdle and shoes which were sprinkled with their
blood.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p5">6. Do therefore - That is, what in reason and justice
thou seest fit. For tho' I was forced to forbear him, yet I never
forgave him; punish him according to his demerits.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p6">7. For so - With such kindness.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p7">8. I will not, &amp;c. - The words are, The king said
unto Shimei, thou shalt not die: and the king swear unto him, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xix. 23" id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|2Sam|19|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.19.23">2 Sam. xix, 23</scripRef>. The oath, we see, was absolute. It was not, "I will not put
thee to death now." or, "I will not put thee to death with the sword."
But who can reconcile his charge to Solomon with this oath? Surely,
considering the time of that charge, this next to the matter of Uriah,
is the greatest blemish in all David's life.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p8">25. Benaiah - For the execution of justice was not then
committed to obscure persons, as now it is; but to persons of great
honour and authority. It is far from clear, that Solomon did right
herein, or that Adonijah had any ill design in asking Abishag.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p9">26. Because, &amp;c. - Thus Solomon shews respect to his
sacred function. He mixes mercy with justice, and requites Abiathar's
former kindness to David; hereby teaching princes, that they should not
write injuries in marble, and benefits in sand, as they have been so
often observed to do.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p10">27. Which he spake - Concerning the translation of the
priesthood from the house of Eli, and of Ithamar, to that of Eleazar:
which being threatened eighty years ago, is now executed. So divine
vengeance, though sometimes it be slow, is always sure.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p11">30. He said, Nay, &amp;c. - For he supposed, either, that
Solomon would not defile that place with his blood, but would spare him
for his respect to it, as he had done Adonijah: or, he had a
superstitious conceit, that his dying there might give his guilty and
miserable soul some advantage.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p12">31. Do, &amp;c. - Kill him, though he be there; take him
from that place, and then kill him: for, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxi. 14" id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Exod|21|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.21.14">Exod. xxi, 14</scripRef>, doth not command the ruler to kill the murderer there, but
to remove him thence, to take him from the altar, that he may die.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p13">34. Wilderness - Places which have but few houses and
inhabitants, are often so called in scripture. He was buried privately,
like a criminal, not pompously, like a general.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p14">36. Go not forth - This Solomon ordered, both for his own
security; and as a penalty for his former wickedness.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p15">37. Kidron - A brook nigh Jerusalem, which he
particularly names, because that was the way to Bahurim, his former
habitation: but this is not all, for the restraint was general, that he
should not go forth thence any whither. Thy blood - The blame and guilt
of thy blood shall lie upon thyself only.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p16">38. Is good - Thy sentence is more merciful than I
expected, or deserved.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p17">39. Achish - A king, but subject and tributary, to
Solomon. Permitted to enjoy the title and honour of a king, but not the
full power; whence it was, that Achish could not keep these servants
though they had fled to him for protection; but suffered Shimei to take
them away from his royal city.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p18">40. To seek his servants - By "seeking his servants, says
Bp. Hall, he lost himself. These earthly things either are, or should be
our servants. How commonly do we see men run out of the bounds set by
God's laws, to hunt after them, till their souls incur a fearful
judgment."</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iii.ii-p19">44. Thine heart - For which thine own conscience accuseth
thee, and there is no need of other witnesses. The Lord - God hath
punished thee for thy former wickedness, by suffering thee to expose
thyself to thy deserved death.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="62.95%" prev="ii.xii.iii.ii" next="ii.xii.iv.i" id="ii.xii.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings III" id="ii.xii.iv-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="62.95%" prev="ii.xii.iv" next="ii.xii.iv.ii" id="ii.xii.iv.i">

<p id="ii.xii.iv.i-p1">Solomon marries Pharaoh's daughter, ver. 1. His religion,
ver. 2-4. His prayer for wisdom, and the answer, ver. 5-15. He decides
the dispute between the two harlots, ver. 16-28.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="62.96%" prev="ii.xii.iv.i" next="ii.xii.v" id="ii.xii.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p1">1. Pharaoh - As being a powerful neighbour, whose
daughter doubtless was first instructed in, and proselyted to the Jewish
religion. It seems, this was designed by God to be a type of Christ,
calling his church to himself, and to the true religion, not only out of
the Jews, but even out of the Gentile world. City of David - Into
David's palace there. The wall - Which though in some sort built by
David, yet Solomon is here said to build, either because he made it
higher, and stronger, in which sense Nebuchadnezzar is said to have
built Babylon, <scripRef passage="Dan. iv. 30" id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Dan|4|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.4.30">Dan. iv, 30</scripRef>, or because he built another wall besides the former, for
after this time Jerusalem was encompassed with more walls than one.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p2">2. Only - This particle is used here, and ver. 3, as an
exception to Solomon's integrity and as a blemish to his government,
That he himself both permitted and practiced this which was expressly
forbidden, <scripRef passage="Levit xvii. 3, 4" id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Lev|17|3|17|4" osisRef="Bible:Lev.17.3-Lev.17.4">Levit xvii, 3, 4</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Deut. xii. 13, 14" id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Deut|12|13|12|14" osisRef="Bible:Deut.12.13-Deut.12.14">Deut. xii, 13, 14</scripRef>. High places - Which were groves, or other convenient places
upon hills, in which the patriarchs used to offer up their sacrifices to
God; and from them this custom was derived both to the Gentiles and the
Jews: and in them the Gentiles sacrificed to idols, the Hebrew to the
true God. Because, &amp;c. - Which reason was not sufficient, for there
was a tabernacle, to which they were as much confined as to the temple, <scripRef passage="Exod. xl. 34-38" id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p2.3" parsed="|Exod|40|34|40|38" osisRef="Bible:Exod.40.34-Exod.40.38">Exod. xl, 34-38</scripRef>, &amp;c.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p3">3. Yet - Although he miscarried in the matter of high
places, yet in the general, his heart was right with God. Statutes -
According to the statutes or commands of God, which are here called the
statutes of David; not only because they were diligently practiced by
David, but also because the observation of them was so earnestly pressed
upon Solomon, and fortified with David's authority and command.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p4">6. Truth - In the true worship of God, in the profession,
belief, practice and defense of the true religion. So truth here
contains all duties to God, as righteousness doth his duties to men, and
uprightness the right manner of performing both sorts of duties. With
thee - That is, in thy judgment, to whom he often appealed as the
witness of his integrity.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p5">7. Child - So he was in years: not above twenty years
old; and withal (which he principally intends) he was raw and
unexperienced, as a child, in state affairs. Go out, &amp;c. - To govern
my people, and manage affairs.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p6">8. In the midst - Is set over them to rule and guide
them. A metaphor from the overseer of divers workmen, who usually is in
the midst of them, that he may the better observe how each of them
discharges his office. Chosen - Thy peculiar people, whom thou takest
special care of, and therefore wilt expect a more punctual account of my
government of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p7">9. An understanding heart - Whereby I may both clearly
discern, and faithfully perform all the parts of my duty: for both these
are spoken of in scripture, as the effects of a good understanding; and
he that lives in the neglect of his duties, or the practice of
wickedness, is called a fool, and one void of understanding. Discern -
Namely in causes and controversies among my people; that I may not
through mistake, or prejudice, or passion, give wrong sentences, and
call evil good, or good evil. Absalom, that was a fool, wished himself a
judge: Solomon, that was a wise man, trembles at the undertaking. The
more knowing and considerate men are, the more jealous they are of
themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p8">13. All thy days - Whereby he signifies that these gifts
of God were not transient, as they were in Saul, but such as should
abide with him whilst he lived.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p9">14. And if - This caution God gives him, lest his wisdom
should make him proud, careless, or presumptuous.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p10">15. A dream - Not a vain dream, wherewith men are
commonly deluded; but a divine dream, assuring him of the thing: which
he knew, by a divine impression after he was awakened: and by the vast
alteration which he presently found within himself in point of wisdom
and knowledge. The ark - Which was there in the city of David, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. vi. 17" id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p10.1" parsed="|2Sam|6|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.6.17">2 Sam. vi, 17</scripRef>, before which he presented himself in a way of holy
adoration. Burnt offerings - Chiefly for the expiation of his and his
peoples sin, through the blood of Christ, manifestly signified in these
sacrifices. Peace offerings - Solemnly to praise God for all his
mercies, and especially for giving him quiet possession of the kingdom,
and for his glorious appearance to him in the dream, and for the promise
therein made to him, and the actual accomplishment of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p11">16. Harlots - Or, victuallers: for the Hebrew words
signifies both. Yet that they are unmarried persons, seems probable,
both because there is no mention of any husbands, whose office it was,
if there were any such, to contest for their wives; and because they
lived a solitary life in one house.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p12">19. Overlaid it - And so smothered it: which she justly
conjectures, because there were evidences of that kind of death, but no
appearance of any other cause thereof.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p13">25. Said - Though with a design far above the reach of
the two women, or of the people present, who probably with horror
expected the execution of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p14">27. She is the mother - As is evident from her natural
affection to the child, which she had rather have given away from her,
than destroyed.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.iv.ii-p15">28. Wisdom of God - Divine wisdom with which God had
inspired him for the government of his people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="63.05%" prev="ii.xii.iv.ii" next="ii.xii.v.i" id="ii.xii.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings IV" id="ii.xii.v-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="63.05%" prev="ii.xii.v" next="ii.xii.v.ii" id="ii.xii.v.i">

<p id="ii.xii.v.i-p1">Solomon's ministers of state, ver. 1-6. The purveyors of
his household, ver. 7-19. The number of his subjects, and extent of his
kingdom, ver. 20, 21. The provision for his table, ver. 22, 23. The
peace of his subjects, ver. 24, 25. His stables, ver. 26-28. His wisdom,
ver. 29-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="63.06%" prev="ii.xii.v.i" next="ii.xii.vi" id="ii.xii.v.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p1">1. All Israel - This is spoken with respect to his
successors, who were kings only over a part, and that the smallest part
of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p2">2. Princes - That is, the chief rulers or officers. The
son - Or the grand-son. The priest - The second priest, or the priest
that attended upon Solomon's person in holy offices and
administrations.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p3">3. Scribes - That is, secretaries of state. He chose two,
whereas David had but one: either, because he observed some
inconveniences in trusting all those matters in one hand: or, because he
had now much more employment than David had, this being a time of great
peace and prosperity, and his empire enlarged.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p4">4. Priests - That is, the high-priests, successively,
first Abiathar, and then Zadok.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p5">5. Officers - Over those twelve Officers, named ver. 7,
&amp;c. who were all to give up their accompts to him. Nathan - The
prophet, who had been so highly instrumental in Solomon's establishment
in the throne. Principal officer - Possibly, president of the king's
council. Friend - His confident, with whom he used to communicate his
most secret counsels.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p6">6. Abiathar was - Steward of the king's household.
Tribute - The personal tribute, or the levy of men, as appears by
comparing this with chap. v, 13, 14, it being very fit that there should
be some one person to whom the chief conduct of that great business was
committed.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p7">8. The son, &amp;c. - This and others of them are
denominated from their fathers, because they were known and famous in
their generation.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p8">10. Hepher - In Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p9">19. Country of Gilead - That is, in the remaining part of
that land of Gilead, which was mentioned above. The only officer - In
all Gilead, excepting the parcels mentioned before, in all the
territories of Sihon and Og; which because they were of large extent,
and yet all committed to this one man, it is here noted concerning him
as his privilege above the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p10">21. The river - Euphrates: for so far David, having
conquered the Syrians, extended his empire, which Solomon also
maintained in that extent. And so God's promise concerning the giving
the whole land, as far as Euphrates, to the Israelites, was fulfilled.
And, if the Israelites had multiplied so much that the land of Canaan
would not suffice them, having God's grant of all the land as far as
Euphrates, they might have seized upon it whensoever occasion required.
The land of the Philistines - Which is to be understood inclusively; for
the Philistines were within Solomon's dominion. The border of Egypt -
Unto the river Sihor, which was the border between Egypt and Canaan. And
served - By tribute, or other ways, as he needed and required.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p11">22. Measures - Hebrew. Cors: each of which contained ten
ephahs. So this provision was sufficient for near three thousand
persons. Meal - Of a coarser sort for common use.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p12">23. Fat - Fatted in stalls. Out of pastures - Well
fleshed, tender and good, though not so fat as the former.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p13">24. Tiphsah - Either that Tiphsah, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xv. 16" id="ii.xii.v.ii-p13.1" parsed="|2Kgs|15|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.15.16">2 Kings xv, 16</scripRef>, which was in the kingdom of Israel within Jordan; or,
rather, another place of that name upon Euphrates, even that eminent
city which is mentioned by Ptolemy, and Strabo, and Pliny, called
Thapsarum. And this best agrees with the following: Azzah, which was the
border of Canaan in the south and west, as Tiphsah was in the north and
east. And so his dominion is described by both its borders. All kings -
Who owned subjection, and paid tribute to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p14">25. Under his vine - Enjoying the fruit of his own labour
with safety and comfort. Under these two trees, which were most used and
cultivated by the Israelites, he understands all other fruit- bearing
trees, and all other comforts. And they are brought in as fitting or
dwelling under these trees, partly for recreation or delight in the
shade; and partly, for the comfort or advantage of the fruit; and
withal, to note their great security, not only in their strong cities,
but even in the country, where the vines and fig-trees grew, which was
most open to the incursions of their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p15">26. Forty thousand - In <scripRef passage="2 Chron. ix. 25" id="ii.xii.v.ii-p15.1" parsed="|2Chr|9|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.9.25">2 Chron. ix, 25</scripRef>, it is but four thousand. But it is not exactly the same
Hebrew word which is here and there, though we translate both stalls;
and therefore there may well be allowed some difference in the
signification, the one signifying properly stables, of which there were
four thousand, the other stalls or partitions for each horse, which were
forty thousand. Chariots - Both for his military chariots, which seem to
be those fourteen hundred, chap. x, 26, and for divers other uses, as
about his great and various buildings, and merchandises, and other
occasions, which might require some thousands of other chariots.
Horsemen - Appointed partly for the defense of his people in peace; and
partly for attendance upon his person, and for the splendour of his
government.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p16">27. The officers - Named above. They lacked - Or rather,
they suffered nothing to be lacking to any man that came thither, but
plentifully provided all things necessary.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p17">29. Largeness of heart - Vastness of understanding, a
most comprehensive knowledge of all things both Divine and human.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p18">30. East country - The Chaldeans, Persians, and Arabians,
who all lay eastward from Canaan, and were famous in ancient times for
their wisdom and learning. Egypt - The Egyptians, whose fame was then
great for their skill in the arts and sciences, which made them despise
the Grecians as children in knowledge.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p19">31. All men - Either of his nation; or, of his time: or,
of all times and nations, whether of the east or any other country
excepting only the first and second Adam. Ethan, &amp;c. - Israelites of
eminent wisdom, probably the same mentioned, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ii. 6" id="ii.xii.v.ii-p19.1" parsed="|1Chr|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.2.6">1 Chron. ii, 6</scripRef>; xv, 19; xxv, 4 <scripRef passage="Psalm 8" id="ii.xii.v.ii-p19.2" parsed="|Ps|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.8">Psalm 8</scripRef>viii, 1(title,) <scripRef passage="Psalm lxxxix. 1" id="ii.xii.v.ii-p19.3" parsed="|Ps|89|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.89.1">Psalm lxxxix, 1</scripRef>(title). Chalcol, &amp;c. - Of whom see <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ii. 6" id="ii.xii.v.ii-p19.4" parsed="|1Chr|2|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.2.6">1 Chron. ii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p20">32. Proverbs - That is, short, and deep, and useful
sentences, whereof a great part are contained in the books of Proverbs
and Ecclesiastes. Songs - Whereof the chief and most divine are in the
Canticles.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p21">33. Trees - That is, of all plants, of their nature and
qualities: all which discourses are lost, without any impeachment of the
perfection of the holy scriptures; which were not written to teach men
philosophy or physick, but only to make them wise unto salvation. From
the cedar, &amp;c. - That is, from the greatest to the least.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.v.ii-p22">34. All kings - All the neighbouring kings; a restriction
grounded upon the following words, where this is limited to such as
heard of Solomon's wisdom. Let those who magnify the modern learning
above that of the ancients, produce such a treasury of learning,
anywhere in these later ages, as that was, which Solomon was master of.
Yet this puts an honour upon human learning, that Solomon is praised for
it, and recommends it to the great ones of the earth, as well worthy
their diligent search. In all this Solomon was a type of Christ, in whom
are hid all the treasures of wisdom and knowledge.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="63.18%" prev="ii.xii.v.ii" next="ii.xii.vi.i" id="ii.xii.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings V" id="ii.xii.vi-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="63.18%" prev="ii.xii.vi" next="ii.xii.vi.ii" id="ii.xii.vi.i">

<p id="ii.xii.vi.i-p1">Hiram congratulates Solomon on his accession, and agrees
to furnish him with workmen and timber for the temple, ver. 1-9. The
work is well done, and the workmen paid, ver. 10-18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="63.18%" prev="ii.xii.vi.i" next="ii.xii.vii" id="ii.xii.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p1">6. They - That is, thy servants. And this assistance
which these Gentiles gave to the building of Solomon's temple, was a
type of the calling of the Gentiles, and that they should be
instrumental in building and constituting Christ's spiritual temple.
Cedar-trees - Which for their soundness, and strength, and fragrancy,
and durableness, were most proper for his design. Of these David had
procured some, but not a sufficient number. Lebanon - Which was in
Solomon's jurisdiction: and therefore he doth not desire that Hiram
would give him the cedars, because they were his own already; but only
that his servants might hew them for him; which the ingenious Tyrians
well understood. With thy servants - Either to be employed therein as
they shall direct; or to receive the cedars, from their hands, and
transmit them to me. Hire - Pay them for their labour and art. Sidonians
- Or Tyrians: for these places and people being near, are promiscuously
used one for another.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p2">7. Rejoiced - Being a faithful friend to David and his
house, and tho' it is not probable he was a sincere proselyte, yet he
had sufficient information concerning the nature and excellency of the
God of Israel, and had honourable thoughts of him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p3">9. The sea - The mid-land sea. Floats - Or, rafts. It is
thought the timber were tied together in the water, as now is usual, and
so by the help of boats or ships, conveyed to the appointed place, which
was at no great distance. Household - My family and court, which most
properly is called his house.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p4">11. Measures - Hebrew. twenty cors pure oil; but in <scripRef passage="2Chr ii. 10" id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|2Chr|2|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.2.10">2Chr ii, 10</scripRef>, it is twenty thousand baths of oil. To which there is added
twenty thousand measures of barley, and twenty thousand baths of wine.
Either therefore, first, he speaks of several things. Or, secondly, he
speaks there of what Solomon offered: for it runs thus, I will give; and
here of what Hiram accepted. Or, thirdly, the barley, and wine, and
twenty thousand baths of common oil, mentioned <scripRef passage="2 Chron. ii. 10" id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p4.2" parsed="|2Chr|2|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.2.10">2 Chron. ii, 10</scripRef>, must be added to the twenty thousand measures of wheat, and
the twenty measures of pure oil here expressed, and the whole sum is to
be made up from both places; that book of Chronicles being written to
supply and compleat the histories of the books of Samuel, and of the
Kings. Gave Hiram - Either, first, for sustenance to the workmen, during
the years wherein they were employed in the cutting down and hewing of
timber. Or, for the yearly support of the king's house, during the said
time. Thus by the wise disposal of providence, one country has need of
another, and is benefited by another, that there may be a mutual
correspondence and dependence, to the glory of God our common
Parent.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p5">13. The levy - Which were to be employed in the most
honourable and easy parts of the work relating to the temple; and these
were Israelites; but those fifteen hundred thousand mentioned ver. 15,
were strangers. If it seem strange, that so many thousands should be
employed about so small a building as the temple was; it must be
considered,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p6">1. that the temple, all its parts being
considered, was far larger than men imagine;</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p7">2. that it is probable, they were employed
by turns, as the thirty thousand were, ver. 14, else they had been
oppressed with hard and uninterrupted labours.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p8">3. that the timber and stone hewed and
carried by them, was designed, not only for the temple, but also for
Solomon's own houses, and buildings; because we read of no other levy of
men, nor of any care and pains taken after the building of the temple,
for the procurement, or preparation of materials for his own houses, or
his other buildings; nay, that this very levy of men was made and
employed for the building of the Lord's house, and Solomon's house, and
Millo, and the wall of Jerusalem, and Hazor, and Megiddo, and Gezer, is
expressed chap. ix, 15.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p9">16. Three thousand &amp;c. - Whereof three thousand were
set over the fifteen hundred thousand, expressed ver. 15, each of these,
over fifty of them, and the odd three hundred were set over these three
thousand, each of these to have the oversight of ten of them, to take an
account of the work for them. But in <scripRef passage="2 Chron. ii. 18" id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|2Chr|2|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.2.18">2 Chron. ii, 18</scripRef>, these overseers are said to be thirty-six hundred. The
three thousand added in <scripRef passage="2 Chron. ii. 2" id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p9.2" parsed="|2Chr|2|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.2.2">2 Chron. ii, 2</scripRef>, might be a reserve, to supply the places of the other three
thousand: yea, or of the thirty-three hundred, as any of them should be
taken off from the work by death, or sickness, or weakness, or necessary
occasions; which was a prudent provision, and not unusual in like cases.
And so there were thirty-six hundred commissioned for the work, but only
thirty-three hundred employed at one time; and therefore both
computations fairly stand together.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p10">17. Great and costly - Marble and porphyry, or other
stones of great size and value. The foundation - Where they could not
afterward be seen: and therefore that this was done, is mentioned only
as a point of magnificence, except it was intended for a type, or
mystical signification of the preciousness of Christ, who is the
foundation of the true temple, the church of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p11">18. Stone-squarers - Hebrew. the Giblites, the
inhabitants of Gebel, a place near Zidon, famous for artificers and
architects, <scripRef passage="Josh. xiii. 5" id="ii.xii.vi.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Josh|13|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.13.5">Josh. xiii, 5</scripRef>. These are here mentioned apart, distinct from the rest of
Hiram's builders, as the most eminent of them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="63.28%" prev="ii.xii.vi.ii" next="ii.xii.vii.i" id="ii.xii.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings VI" id="ii.xii.vii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="63.28%" prev="ii.xii.vii" next="ii.xii.vii.ii" id="ii.xii.vii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.vii.i-p1">The time when the temple was built, ver. 1. The
dimensions of it, ver. 2, 3. The windows, chambers, materials, doors,
ver. 4-10. God's message to Solomon, ver. 11-13. The walls and flooring,
ver. 14-18. The oracle and cherubim, ver. 19-30. The doors and inner
court, ver. 31-36. How long it was building, ver. 37-38.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="63.28%" prev="ii.xii.vii.i" next="ii.xii.viii" id="ii.xii.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p1">1. Four hundred and four score, &amp;c. - Allowing forty
years to Moses, seventeen to Joshua, two hundred ninety-nine to the
Judges, forty to Eli, forty to Samuel and Saul, forty to David, and four
to Solomon before he began the work, we have just the sum of four
hundred and eighty. So long it was before that holy house was built,
which in less than four hundred and thirty years was burnt by
Nebuchadnezzar. It was thus deferred, because Israel had by their sins,
made themselves unworthy of this honour: and because God would shew how
little he values external pomp and splendour in his service. And God
ordered it now, chiefly to be a shadow of good things to come.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p2">2. The house - Properly so called, as distinct from all
the walls and buildings which were adjoining to it; namely, the holy,
and most holy place. Length - From east, to west. And this and the other
measures may seem to belong to the inside from wall to wall. Cubits -
Cubits of the sanctuary. Height - Namely, of the house: for the porch
was one hundred and twenty cubits high, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. iii. 4" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Chr|3|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.3.4">2
Chron. iii, 4</scripRef>. So that all the measures compared each with other were
harmonious. For sixty to twenty (the length to the breadth) is triple:
or as three to one: and sixty to thirty (the length to the height) is
double, or as two to one: and thirty to twenty (the height to the
breadth) is one and an half, as three to two. Which are the proportions
answering to the three great concords in music, commonly called, a
twelfth, an eighth, and a fifth. Which therefore must needs be a
graceful proportion to the eye, as that in music is graceful to the
ear.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p3">3. The porch - In the front of, or entrance into the
house, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. iii. 4" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|2Chr|3|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.3.4">2 Chron.
iii, 4</scripRef>, being a portico, a walk or gallery, at one end of the
building (from side to side.) And the measures of this were harmonious
also. For twenty to ten (the length of the portico to the breadth of it)
is double, or as two to one. And, if the height within, be the same with
that of the house, that is thirty; it will be to the length of it, as
three to two; and to its breadth, as three to one. Or, if we take in the
whole height mentioned, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. iii. 4" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p3.2" parsed="|2Chr|3|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.3.4">2 Chron. iii, 4</scripRef>, which is one hundred and twenty; there is in this no
disproportion: being to its length as six to one; and to its breadth as
twelve to one; especially when this height was conveniently divided into
several galleries, one over another, each of which had their due
proportions.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p4">4. Narrow - Narrow outward, to prevent the inconveniences
of the weather; widening by degrees inward, that so the house might
better receive, and more disperse the light.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p5">5. Against the wall - The beams of the chambers were not
fastened into the wall, but leaned upon the buttresses of the wall.
Chambers - For the laying the priests garments, and other utensils
belonging to the temple, therein. Round about - On all the sides except
the east, where the porch was; and except some very small passages for
the light. And yet these lights might be in the five uppermost cubits of
the wall, which were above all these chambers, for these were only
fifteen cubits high, and the wall was twenty cubits high. Chambers -
Galleries which encompassed all the chambers; and which were necessary
for passage to them.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p6">6. Broad - On the inside, and besides the galleries
mentioned above. Narrowed rests - Or, narrowings: as in our buildings
the walls of an house are thicker, or broader at the bottom, and
narrower towards the top: only these narrowings were in the outside of
the wall, which at each of the three stories was a cubit narrower than
that beneath it. And this is mentioned, as the reason of the differing
breadth of the chambers; because the wall being narrower, allowed more
space for the upper chambers. Not fastened - That there might be no
holes made in the wall for fastening them; and that the chambers might
be removed, if occasion were, without any inconvenience to the
house.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p7">7. Made ready - Hewed, and squared, and fitted exactly
according to the direction of the architect. Neither hammer, &amp;c. -
So it was ordered, partly for the ease and conveniency of carriage:
partly, for the magnificence of the work, and commendation of the
workmen's skill and diligence: and partly, for mystical signification.
And as this temple was a manifest type both of Christ's church upon
earth, and of the heavenly Jerusalem: so this circumstance signified as
to the former, that it is the duty of the builders and members of the
church, as far as in them lies, to take care that all things be
transacted there with perfect peace and quietness; and that no noise of
contention, or division, or violence, be heard in that sacred building:
and for the latter, that no spiritual stone, no person, shall bear a
part in that heavenly temple, unless he be first hewed, and squared, and
made meet for it in this life.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p8">8. The door - That is, by which they entered to go up to
the middle chamber or chambers; such as were in the middle story. Right
side - That is, in the south-side, called the right side; because when a
man looks towards the east, the south is on his right hand. There was
another door on the left, or the north-side, leading to the chambers on
that side. Winding stairs - Without the wall, leading up to the gallery
out of which they went into the several chambers. Middle chamber - Or
rather, into the middle story, or row of chambers; and so in the
following words, out of the middle story: for these stair's could not
lead up into each of the chambers; nor was it needful, but only into the
story, which was sufficient for the use of all the chambers.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p9">10. Built chambers - The Hebrew words may be properly
rendered, He built a roof, a flat and plain roof, over all the house,
according to the manner of the Israelitish buildings. The inner roof was
arched, ver. 9, that it might be the more beautiful, but the outward
roof was flat. Five cubits - Above the walls of the temple: that it
might be a little higher than the arched roof, which it was designed to
cover and secure. They rested - Hebrew. it rested, namely, the roof.
Timber of cedar - Which rested upon the top of the wall, as the
chambers, ver. 5, rested upon the sides of the wall.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p10">12. If - God expresses the condition upon which his
promise and favour is suspended; and by assuring him thereof in case of
obedience, he plainly intimates the contrary upon his disobedience. Thus
he was taught, that all the charge he and the people were at, in
erecting this temple, would neither excuse them from obedience to the
law of God, nor shelter them from his judgments in case of
disobedience.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p11">15. Walls - The name of a wall is not appropriated to
stone or brick, because we read of a brazen wall, <scripRef passage="Jer. xv. 20" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Jer|15|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.15.20">Jer. xv, 20</scripRef>, and a wall of iron, <scripRef passage="Ezek iv. 3" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p11.2" parsed="|Ezek|4|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.4.3">Ezek iv, 3</scripRef>. And that wall into which Saul smote his javelin, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xix. 10" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p11.3" parsed="|1Sam|19|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.19.10">1
Sam. xix, 10</scripRef>, seems more probably to be understood of wood, than of
stone; especially, considering that it was the room where the king used
to dine. By this periphrasis, from the floor of the house, unto the
walls of the ceiling, he designs all the side-walls of the house. Them -
The side-walls of the house. Wood - With other kind of wood, even with
fir; as appears from <scripRef passage="2 Chron. iii. 5" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p11.4" parsed="|2Chr|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.3.5">2 Chron. iii, 5</scripRef>, wherewith the floor is here said to be covered. Floor -
This is spoken only concerning the floor, because there was nothing but
planks of fir; whereas there was both cedar and fir in the sides of the
house, the fir being either put above, or upon the cedar; or intermixed
with, or put between the boards or ribs of cedar: as may be gathered
from, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. iii. 5" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p11.5" parsed="|2Chr|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.3.5">2 Chron. iii, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p12">16. House - That is, the most holy place, which contained
in length twenty cubits, which may be said to be on the sides Of the
house, because this part took off twenty cubits in length from each side
of the house, and was also twenty cubits from side to side, so it was
twenty cubits every way. The oracle-the most holy place - The last words
are added, to explain what he means by the word oracle, which he had not
used before.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p13">17. House - That is, the holy place. Temple - This is
added, to restrain the signification of the word house, which otherwise
notes the whole building. It - The oracle.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p14">18. Cedar - Cedar is here named, not to exclude all other
wood, but stone only; as the following words shew.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p15">19. Prepared - That is, adorned and fitted it for the
receipt of the ark. Solomon made every thing new, but the ark. That with
its mercy seat was still the same that Moses made. This was the token of
God's presence, which is with his people, whether they meet in tent or
temple, and changes not with their condition.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p16">20. Forepart - Which was in the inner part of the house,
called in Hebrew, the forepart; not because a man first enters there,
but because when a man is entering, or newly entered into the house, it
is still before him. Covered - With gold, chap. vii, 48; <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xxviii. 18" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p16.1" parsed="|1Chr|28|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.28.18">1 Chron.
xxviii, 18</scripRef>. The altar - The altar of incense.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p17">21. House - Or, that house, the oracle. Partition - He
made a veil, which was a farther partition between the holy, and the
most holy; which veil did hang upon these golden chains. Before the
oracle - In the outward part of the wall, or partition, which was
erected between the oracle and the holy place; which is properly said to
be before the oracle, there the veil was hung; and there the chains or
bars, or whatsoever it was which fastened the doors of the oracle, were
placed. It - The partition; which he here distinguisheth from the house,
or the main walls of the house, which he had in the former part of this
verse told us were overlaid with gold; and now he affirms much as of the
partition.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p18">22. Whole house - Not only the oracle, but all the holy
place. The altar - the altar of incense, which was set in the holy place
close by the doors of the oracle. With gold - As before he overlaid it
with cedar.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p19">23. Cherubim - Besides those two made by Moses, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxv. 18" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Exod|25|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.25.18">Exod. xxv, 18</scripRef>, which were of gold, and far less than these. The Heathens
set up images of their gods, and worshipped them. These were designed to
represent the servants and attendants of the God of Israel, the holy
angels, not to be worshipped themselves, but to shew how great he is
whom we worship.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p20">29. Cherubim - As signs of the presence and protection of
the angels vouch-safed by God to that place. Palm-trees - Emblems of
that peace and victory over their enemies, which the Israelites duly
serving God in that place might expect. Within and without - Within the
oracle and without it, in the holy place.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p21">31. Fifth part - That is, four cubits in height or
breadth, whereas the wall was twenty cubits.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p22">36. Inner court - The priests court, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. iv. 9" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p22.1" parsed="|2Chr|4|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.4.9">2 Chron. iv, 9</scripRef>, so called, because it was next to the temple which it
compassed. Cedar beams - Which is understood, of so many galleries, one
on each side of the temple, whereof the three first were of stone, and
the fourth of cedar, all supported with rows of pillars: upon which
there were many chambers for the uses of the temple, and of the
priests.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p23">38. Seven years - It is not strange that this work took
up so much time: for,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p24">1. The temple properly so called, was for
quantity the least part of it, there being very many and great buildings
both above ground in the several courts, (for though only the court of
the priests be mentioned, yet it is thereby implied, that the same thing
was proportionably done in the others) and under ground.</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p25">2. The great art which was used here, and
the small number of exquisite artists, required the longer time for the
doing it. And if the building of Diana's temple employed all Asia for
two hundred years; and the building of one pyramid employed three
hundred and sixty thousand men, for twenty years together; both which,
Pliny affirms: no reasonable man can wonder that this temple was seven
years in building. Now let us see what this temple typifies.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p26">1. Christ himself is the true temple. He
himself spoke of the temple of his body: and in him dwelt all the
fulness of the godhead. In him all the Israel of God meet, and thro' him
have access with confidence to God.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p27">2. Every believer is a living temple, in
whom the spirit of God dwelleth. We are wonderfully made by the Divine
Providence, but more wonderfully made anew by the Divine grace. And as
Solomon's temple was built on a rock, so are we built on Christ.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p28">3. The church is a mystical temple,
enriched and beautified, not with gold and precious stones, but with the
gifts and graces of the spirit. Angels are ministering spirits,
attending the church and all the members of it on all sides.</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.xii.vii.ii-p29">4. Heaven is the everlasting temple. There
the church will be fixt, and no longer moveable. The cherubim there
always attend upon the throne of glory. In the temple there was no noise
of axes or hammers: every thing is quiet and serene in heaven. All that
shall be stones in that building, must here be fitted and made ready for
it; must be hewn and squared by the Divine grace, and so made meet for a
place in that temple.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="63.51%" prev="ii.xii.vii.ii" next="ii.xii.viii.i" id="ii.xii.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings VII" id="ii.xii.viii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="63.51%" prev="ii.xii.viii" next="ii.xii.viii.ii" id="ii.xii.viii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.viii.i-p1">Solomon builds several other houses, ver. 1-12. He
furnishes the temple with two pillars, ver. 13-22. With a molten sea,
ver. 23-26. With ten bases and ten lavers of brass, ver. 27-39. With all
other utensils, and the things David had dedicated, ver. 40-51.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="63.51%" prev="ii.xii.viii.i" next="ii.xii.ix" id="ii.xii.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p1">1. House - The royal palace for himself, and for his
successors. Thirteen years - Almost double the time to that in which the
temple was built; because neither were the materials so far provided and
prepared for this, as they were for the temple: nor did either he or his
people use the same diligence in this, as in the other work; to which
they were quickened by God's express command.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p2">2. Of the forest of Lebanon - An house so called, because
it was built in the forest of Lebanon, for a summer-seat, whither
Solomon, having so many chariots and horses, might at any time retire
with ease. The length - Of the principal mansion; to which doubtless
other buildings were adjoining. Pillars - Upon which the house was
built, and between which there were four stately walks. Beams - Which
were laid for the floor of the second story.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p3">3. Fifteen - So in this second story were only three rows
of pillars, which was sufficient for the ornament of the second and for
the support of the third story.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p4">4. Against light - One directly opposite to the other, as
is usual in well-contrived buildings. In ranks - One exactly under
another.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p5">5. Windows - He speaks, of smaller windows or lights,
which were over the several doors.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p6">6. A porch - Supported by divers pillars, for the more
magnificent entrance into the house; upon which also it is thought there
were other rooms built, as in the house. The porch - Now mentioned which
is said to be before them; before the pillars on which the house of
Lebanon stood. Pillars - Or, and pillars; That is, fewer and lesser
pillars for the support of the lesser porch. Beam - Which was laid upon
these pillars, as the others were ver. 2.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p7">7. A porch - Another porch or distinct room without the
house. The other - The whole floor; or, from floor to floor, from the
lower floor on the ground, to the upper floor which covered it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p8">8. Another court - That is, between the porch and the
house, called therefore the middle court, chap. <scripRef passage="2 Kings xx. 4" id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|2Kgs|20|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.20.4">2 Kings xx, 4</scripRef>. Like this - Not for form or quantity, but for the materials
and workmanship, the rooms being covered with cedar, and furnished with
like ornaments.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p9">9. These - Buildings described here and in the former
chapter. The measures - Hewed in such measure and proportion as exact
workmen use to hew ordinary stones. Within, &amp;c. - Both on the inside
of the buildings which were covered with cedar, and on the outside also.
To the coping - From the bottom to the top of the building. And so on -
Not only on the outside of the front of the house, which being most
visible, men are more careful to adorn; but also of the other side of
the house, which looked towards the great court belonging to the king's
house.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p10">11. Above - That is, in the upper part; for this is
opposed to the foundation. Stones and cedars - Intermixed the one, and
the other.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p11">12. The court - Namely, of Solomon's dwelling-house
mentioned, ver. 8.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p12">14. In brass - And Of gold, and stone, and purple, and
blue, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. ii. 14" id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p12.1" parsed="|2Chr|2|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.2.14">2
Chron. ii, 14</scripRef>. But only his skill in brass is here mentioned, because he
speaks only of the brasen things which he made.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p13">16. Five cubits - The word chapiter is taken either more
largely for the whole, so it is five cubits; Or, more strictly, either
for the pommels, as they are called, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. iv. 12" id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p13.1" parsed="|2Chr|4|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.4.12">2 Chron. iv, 12</scripRef>, or for the cornice or crown, and so it was but three
cubits, to which the pomegranates being added make it four cubits, as it
is below, ver. 19, and the other work upon it took up one cubit more,
which in all made five cubits.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p14">17. The chapiters - Which those nets and wreathes
encompass, either covering, and as it were receiving and holding the
pomegranates, or being mixed with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p15">18. Two rows - Either of pomegranates, by comparing this
with ver. 20, or of some other curious work.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p16">19. Lilly work - Made like the leaves of lillies. In the
porch - Or, as in the porch; such work as there was in the porch of the
temple, in which these pillars were set, ver. 21, that so the work of
the tops of these pillars might agree with that in the top of the
porch.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p17">20. The belly - So he calls the middle part of the
chapiter, which jetted farthest out. Two hundred - They are said to be
ninety and six on a side of a pillar; in one row and in all an hundred, <scripRef passage="Jer. lii. 23" id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Jer|52|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.52.23">Jer. lii,
23</scripRef>, four great pomegranates between the several checker-works
being added to the first ninety six. And it must needs be granted, that
there were as many on the other side of the pillar, or in the other row,
which makes them two hundred upon a pillar, as is here said, and four
hundred upon both pillars, as they are numbered, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. iv. 13" id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p17.2" parsed="|2Chr|4|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.4.13">2 Chron. iv, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p18">21. Jachin - Jachin signifies he; That is, God shall
establish, his temple, and church, and people: and Boaz signifies, in
it, or rather, in him (to answer the he in the former name) is strength.
So these pillars being eminently strong and stable, were types of that
strength which was in God, and would be put forth by God for the
defending and establishing of his temple and people, if they were
careful to keep the conditions required by God on their parts.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p19">23. A Sea - He melted the brass, and cast it into the
form of a great vessel, for its vastness called a sea, which name is
given by the Hebrew to all great collections of waters. The use of it
was for the priests to wash their hands and feet, or other things as
occasion required, with the water which they drew out of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p20">24. Knops - Carved or molten figures: for this word
signifies figures or pictures of all sorts. Ten, &amp;c. - So there were
three hundred in all. Cast - Together with the sea; not carved. Two rows
- It seems doubtful whether the second row had ten in each cubit, and so
there were three hundred more; or, whether the ten were distributed into
five in each row.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p21">25. Oxen - Of solid brass, which was necessary to bear so
great a weight.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p22">26. Baths - Which amounts to five hundred barrels, each
bath containing about eight gallons; the bath being a measure of the
same bigness with an ephah.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p23">27. Bases - Upon which stood the ten lavers mentioned
below, ver. 38, in which they washed the parts of the sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p24">28. Borders - Broad brims, possibly for the more secure
holding of the lavers.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p25">29. Base above - So he calls the upper-most part of the
base: for though it was above, yet it was a base to the laver, which
stood upon it. Additions - Either as bases for the feet of the said
lions and oxen: or, only as farther ornaments.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p26">30. Wheels - Whereby the bases and lavers might be
removed from place to place as need required. Under-setters - Hebrew.
shoulders; fitly so called, because they supported the lavers, that they
should not fall from their bases, when the bases were removed together
with the lavers.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p27">31. The mouth - So he calls that part in the top of the
base which was left hollow, that the foot of the laver might be let into
it. The chapiter - Within the little base, which he calls the chapiter,
because it rose up from, and stood above the great base. Above - Above
the chapiter; for the mouth went up, and grew wider like a funnel. A
cubit - In height, ver. 35, whereof half a cubit was above the chapiter
or little base, and the other half below it. A cubit and half - In
compass. Four square - So the innermost part, called the mouth, was
round, but the outward part was square, as when a circle is made within
a quadrangle.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p28">33. Molten - And cast together with the bases.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p29">34. Of the base - Not only of the same matter, but of the
same piece, being cast with it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p30">36. The proportion - Or, empty place, that is, according
to the bigness of the spaces which were left empty for them, implying
that they were smaller than those above mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p31">39. Right side - In the south side, not within the house,
but in the priests court, where they washed either their hands or feet,
or the parts of the sacrifices. Left side - On the north side. The south
- In the southeast part, where the offerings were prepared.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p32">45. The pots - To boil those parts of the sacrifices
which the priests, &amp;c. were to eat.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p33">48. Vessels - Such as Moses had made only these were
larger, and richer, and more. Table of gold - Under which, are
comprehended both all the utensils belonging to it, and the other ten
tables which he made together with it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p34">49. Candlesticks - Which were ten, according to the
number of the tables, whereas Moses made but one: whereby might be
signified the progress of the light of sacred truth, which was now grown
clearer than it was in Moses's time, and should shine brighter and
brighter until the perfect day of gospel light. Pure gold - Of massy and
fine gold. The oracle - In the holy place. Flowers - Wrought upon the
candlesticks, as it had formerly been.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.viii.ii-p35">51. Silver and gold - So much of it as was left. And
vessels - Those which David had dedicated, and with them the altar of
Moses, and some other of the old utensils which were now laid aside, far
better being put in the room of them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="63.67%" prev="ii.xii.viii.ii" next="ii.xii.ix.i" id="ii.xii.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings VIII" id="ii.xii.ix-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="63.67%" prev="ii.xii.ix" next="ii.xii.ix.ii" id="ii.xii.ix.i">

<p id="ii.xii.ix.i-p1">The chief men of Israel called together, ver. 1, 2. The
ark fixt in the most holy place, ver. 3-9. God takes possession of it by
a cloud, ver. 10-12. Solomon tells the people the occasion of their
meeting, ver. 13-21. The prayer of dedication, ver. 22-53. He dismisses
the assembly with a blessing and an exhortation, ver. 54-61. Offers
abundance of sacrifices, ver. 62-66.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="63.68%" prev="ii.xii.ix.i" next="ii.xii.x" id="ii.xii.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p1">1. Elders - The senators, and Judges, and rulers. Heads -
For each tribe had a peculiar governor. Chief - The chief persons of
every great family in each tribe. Jerusalem - Where the temple was
built. Bring the ark - To the top of Moriah, upon which it was built;
whither they were now to carry the ark in solemn pomp. City of David -
Where David had placed the ark, which is called Zion, because it was
built upon that hill.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p2">2. All Israel - Not only the chief men, but a vast number
of the common people. The feast - The feast of the dedication, to which
Solomon had invited them. Seventh month - Which time he chose with
respect to his peoples convenience, because now they had gathered in all
their fruits, and were come up to Jerusalem, to celebrate the feast of
tabernacles. But the temple was not finished till the eighth month,
chap. vi, 38, how then could he invite them in the seventh month? This
was the seventh month of the next year. For although the house in all
its parts was finished the year before, yet the utensils of it were not
then fully finished: and many preparations were to be made for this
great and extraordinary occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p3">3. The priests - For although the Levites might do this, <scripRef passage="Num. iv. 15" id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Num|4|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.4.15">Num. iv,
15</scripRef>, yet the priests did it at this time, for the greater honour
of the solemnity; and because the Levites might not enter into the holy-
place, much less into the holy of holies, where it was to be placed,
into which the priests themselves might not have entered, if the
high-priest alone could have done it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p4">4. The tabernacle - That made by Moses, which doubtless
before this time had been translated from Gibeon to Zion, and now
together with other things, was put into the treasuries of the Lord's
house, to prevent all superstitious use of it, and to oblige the people
to come up to Jerusalem, as the only place where God would now be
worshipped.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p5">5. Sacrificing - When the ark was seated in its place:
for although they might in the way offer some sacrifices, as David did;
yet that was not a proper season to offer so many sacrifices as could
not be numbered. This is more particularly related below, ver. 62, 63,
64, which is here signified by way of anticipation.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p6">6. Cherubim - Of Solomon's new made cherubim, not of the
Mosaic cherubim, which were far less, and unmovably fixed to the ark, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxvii. 7, 8" id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Exod|37|7|37|8" osisRef="Bible:Exod.37.7-Exod.37.8">Exod. xxxvii, 7, 8</scripRef>, and therefore together with the ark, were put under the
wings of these cherubim.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p7">8. Drew out - Not wholly, which was expressly forbidden, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxv. 15" id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Exod|25|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.25.15">Exod.
xxv, 15</scripRef>, <scripRef passage="Num. iv. 6" id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p7.2" parsed="|Num|4|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.4.6">Num. iv, 6</scripRef>, but in part. Seen out - In the most holy place, which is
oft called by way of eminency, the holy place, and the Hebrew words
rendered before the oracle, may be as well rendered, within the oracle.
And these staves were left in this posture, that the high-priest might
hereby be certainly guided to that very place where he, was one day in a
year to sprinkle blood, and to offer incense before the ark, which
otherwise he might mistake in that dark place, where the ark was wholly
covered with the wings of the great cherubim, which stood between him
and the ark when he entered in.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p8">9. Nothing - Strictly and properly: but in a more large
sense, the pot of manna, and Aaron's rod were also in it, <scripRef passage="Heb. ix. 4" id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Heb|9|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.9.4">Heb. ix, 4</scripRef>, that is, by it, in the most holy place, before the ark of
the testimony, where God commanded Moses to put them.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p9">10. The cloud - The usual token of God's glorious
presence. Filled - In testimony of his gracious acceptance of this work,
and their service; and to beget an awe and reverence in them, and in all
others, when they approach to God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p10">12. Then spake - Perceiving both priests and people
struck with wonder at this darkness, he minds them, that this was no
sign of God's disfavour, as some might possibly imagine; but a token of
his approbation, and special presence among them. Said - He hath
declared, that he would manifest his presence with, and dwelling among
his people, by a dark cloud, in which he would appear.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p11">14. Turned - From the temple to the body of the
congregation. Stood - In token of reverence, and of their readiness to
receive the blessing.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p12">16. Since, &amp;c. - Until David's time; for then he did
chuse Jerusalem. That my name - That my presence, and grace, and
worship, and glory, might be there. Chose David - And in and with him
the tribe of Judah, of which he was, and Jerusalem where he dwelt.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p13">21. The covenant - The tables of the covenant, wherein
the conditions of God's covenant with Israel are written.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p14">22. Stood - Upon a scaffold set up for him in the court
of the people, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. vi. 13" id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p14.1" parsed="|2Chr|6|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.6.13">2 Chron. vi, 13</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p15">24. Hast kept - That branch of thy promise concerning the
building of this house by David's son.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p16">25. Keep - Make good the other branch of thy promise.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p17">27. But will - Is it possible that the great, and high,
and lofty God should stoop so low, as to take up his dwelling amongst
men? The heaven - All this vast space of the visible heaven. And heaven,
&amp;c. - The third and highest, and therefore the largest heaven,
called the heaven of heavens for its eminency and comprehensiveness.
Contain - For thy essence reacheth far beyond them, being omnipresent.
Much less - This house therefore was not built as if it were
proportionable to thy greatness, or could contain thee, but only that
therein we might serve and glorify thee.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p18">28. Yet - Tho' thou art not comprehended within this
place, yet shew thyself to be graciously present here, by accepting and
granting my present requests here tendered unto thee.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p19">29. Open - To behold with an eye of favour. My name - My
presence, and glory and grace. This place - This temple, to which
Solomon did now look, and towards which, the godly Israelites directed
their looks in their prayers.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p20">30. In heaven - Which he adds to direct them in their
addresses to God in this temple, to lift up their eyes above it, even to
heaven, where God's most true, and most glorious dwelling-place is.
Forgive - The sins of thy people, praying, and even of their prayers;
which, if not pardoned, will certainly hinder the success of all their
prayers, and the course of all thy blessings.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p21">31. Trespass - If he be accused of a trespass. Laid on
him - Either by the judge, or by the party accusing him, or by the
accused person himself: which was usual, when there were no witnesses.
Thine altar - For here God, who was appealed to as witness, was
especially present. Hence the Heathens used to swear at their
altars.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p22">32. His way - The just recompence of his wicked action.
Give him, &amp;c. - To vindicate him, and manifest his integrity.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p23">33. Confess - Give glory to thy name, by acknowledging
their sins, and by justice; and by accepting the punishment of their
iniquity; and by trusting to thy power and goodness alone, for their
deliverance.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p24">35. Heaven - The lower heaven in which the clouds are.
Shut up - Heaven is compared to a great store-house in God's keeping,
out of which nothing can be had, so long as it is close shut up.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p25">36. Good way - The way, of their duty, which is good in
itself; and both delightful and profitable, to those that walk in it.
Give rain - The order of Solomon's prayer is very observable; first and
chiefly, he prays for their repentance and forgiveness, which is the
chief blessing, and the only solid foundation of all other mercies: and
then he prays for temporal mercies; thereby teaching us what to desire
principally in our prayers; which also Christ hath taught us in his
perfect prayer; wherein there is but one petition for outward, and all
the rest are for spiritual blessings.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p26">38. The plague - His sin, which may be called the plague
of his heart, in opposition to the other plagues here mentioned; so the
sense is, who, by their afflictions are brought to a true and serious
sense of their worse and inward plague of their sins, which are most
fitly called the plague of the heart, because that is both the principal
seat of sin, and the fountain from whence all actual sins flow.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p27">39. Thou knowest - Not only the plagues of their hearts,
their several wants and burdens, (these he knows! but he will know them
from us,) but the desire and intent of the heart, the sincerity or
hypocrisy of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p28">41. A stranger - A proselyte. But cometh - That he may
worship, and glorify thy name.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p29">43. Calleth for - Agreeable to thy will and word. It is
observable, that his prayer for the strangers is more large, and
comprehensive, than for the Israelites; that thereby he might both shew
his public- spiritedness, and encourage strangers to the worship of the
true God. Thus early were the indications of God's favour, toward the
sinners of the Gentiles. As there was then one law for the native and
for the stranger, so there was one gospel for both.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p30">44. To battle - In a just cause, and by thy warrant or
commission. Shall pray - Whereby he instructs them, that they should not
trust, either to the strength or justice of their arms, but only to
God's help and blessing. Chosen - For thy dwelling-place, and the seat
of thy temple. Towards the house - For to it they were to turn their
faces in prayer; to profess themselves worshippers of the true God, in
opposition to idols; and to strengthen their faith in God's promises and
covenant, the tables whereof were contained in that house. Soldiers in
the field must not think it enough that others pray for them: they must
pray for themselves. And they are here encouraged to expect a gracious
answer. Praying should always go along with fighting.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p31">48. And return - Sincerely, universally, and
steadfastly.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p32">49. Their course - Hebrew. their right, against their
invaders and oppressors. For they had forfeited all their rights to God
only, but not to their enemies; whom tho' God used as scourges to
chastise his peoples sins, yet they had no pretense of right to their
land.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p33">55. He stood - He spoke this standing, that he might be
the better heard, and because he blessed as one having authority. Never
were words more pertinently spoken: never was a congregation dismissed,
with that which was more likely to affect them, and to abide with
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p34">56. Blessed, &amp;c. - This discharge he gives in the
name of all Israel, to the everlasting honour of the Divine
faithfulness, and the everlasting encouragement of all those that build
upon the Divine promises.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p35">58. Incline - That he may not only bless us with outward
prosperity, but especially, with spiritual blessings: and that as he
hath given us his word to teach and direct us, so he would by his holy
Spirit, effectually incline us to obey it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p36">61. Perfect - Let your obedience be universal, without
dividing; upright, without dissembling; and constant, without
declining.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p37">63. Offered - Not all in one day, but in the seven, or it
may be in the fourteen days, mentioned ver. 65.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p38">64. Middle of the court - Of the priests court, in which
the great altar was. This he consecrated as he did the great altar, by
sacrifices; but with this difference, that he consecrated that for
perpetual use: but this only for the present occasion, being warranted
to do so both by the necessity of it for God's service, and for the
present solemn work, for which the brazen altar was not sufficient; and
by the direction of God's spirit, wherewith Solomon was endowed, as
being a prophet, as well as a king. Here therefore he suddenly reared up
divers altars, which, after this solemnity were demolished.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p39">65. Seven - Seven for the dedication of the temple, or
altar; and the other seven for the feast of tabernacles. And it seems to
be expressed in this manner, to intimate, that these fourteen days of
rejoicing, were not altogether, but that there was some interval between
them, which indeed was necessary, because the day of atonement was on
the tenth day of this month, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxiii. 27" id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p39.1" parsed="|Lev|23|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.23.27">Lev. xxiii, 27</scripRef>. And because these fourteen days ended on the twenty-second
day, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. vii. 10" id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p39.2" parsed="|2Chr|7|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.7.10">2
Chron. vii, 10</scripRef>, it may seem most probable, that the feast of the dedication
was kept before the tenth day: and the feast of tabernacles some days
after it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.ix.ii-p40">66. He sent - Solomon having joined with the people in
the solemn assembly, which was kept on the eighth day; in the close of
that day took his solemn farewell, and dismissed them with his blessing;
and the next morning when the heads and elders with divers of the people
came to take their leave of the king, he sent them away.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="63.89%" prev="ii.xii.ix.ii" next="ii.xii.x.i" id="ii.xii.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings IX" id="ii.xii.x-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="63.89%" prev="ii.xii.x" next="ii.xii.x.ii" id="ii.xii.x.i">

<p id="ii.xii.x.i-p1">God in a vision answers Solomon's prayer, ver. 1-9. The
mutual presents of Solomon and Hiram, ver. 10-14. His workmen and
buildings, ver. 15-24. His devotion, ver. 25. His navy, ver. 26- 28.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="63.90%" prev="ii.xii.x.i" next="ii.xii.xi" id="ii.xii.x.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p1">3. For ever - As long as the Mosaic dispensation lasts;
whereas hitherto my worship has been successively in several places.
Eyes - My watchful and gracious providence. Heart - My tender affection.
Shall be there - Shall be towards this place and people.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p2">5. Then - Upon that condition; for my promise to David
was conditional.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p3">8. High - Glorious and renowned. Astonished - At its
unexpected and wonderful ruin. Hiss - By way of contempt and
derision.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p4">11. Galilee - Or, near the land of Galilee, bordering
upon it; in those parts which were near, and adjoining to Hiram's
dominions: with the cities, understand the territories belonging to
them. These cities, though they were within those large bounds which God
fixed to the land of promise, <scripRef passage="Gen. xv. 18" id="ii.xii.x.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Gen|15|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.15.18">Gen. xv, 18</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Josh. i. 4" id="ii.xii.x.ii-p4.2" parsed="|Josh|1|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.1.4">Josh. i, 4</scripRef>, yet were not within those parts which were distributed by
lot in Joshua's time. It is probable they were not inhabited by
Israelites, but by Canaanites, or other Heathens; who being subdued, and
extirpated by David or Solomon, those cities became a part of their
dominions; and afterwards were reckoned a part of Galilee, as Josephus
notes.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p5">13. Cabul - That is, of dirt, as most interpret it.
Because, though the land was very good, yet being a thick and stiff
clay, and therefore requiring great pains to manure it, it was very
unsuitable to the disposition of the Tyrians, who were delicate, and
lazy, and luxurious, and wholly given to merchandise. And on his
returning them, there is no doubt but Solomon gave him an equivalent
more to his taste.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p6">14. Sent - And this seems to be here added, both to
declare the quantity of the gold sent, which had been only named before,
ver. 11, and as the reason why he resented Solomon's action, because so
great a sum required a better recompense.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p7">15. Raised - Both the levy of men; of which, chap. v, 13,
and the levy of money upon his people and subjects. He raised this levy,
both to pay what he owed to Hiram, and to build the works following.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p8">21. Those - He used them as bondmen, and imposed bodily
labours upon them. "But why did not Solomon destroy them as God had
commanded, when now it was fully in his power to do so?" The command of
destroying them, <scripRef passage="Deut. vii. 2" id="ii.xii.x.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Deut|7|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.7.2">Deut. vii, 2</scripRef>, did chiefly, if not only, concern that generation of
Canaanites, who lived in, or, near the time of the Israelites entering
into Canaan. And that command seems not to be absolute, but conditional,
and with some exception for those who should submit and embrace the true
religion, as may be gathered both from <scripRef passage="Josh. xi. 19" id="ii.xii.x.ii-p8.2" parsed="|Josh|11|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.11.19">Josh. xi, 19</scripRef>, and from the history of the Gibeonites. For if God's
command had been absolute, the oaths of Joshua, and of the princes,
could not have obliged them, nor dispensed with such a command.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p9">25. Three times - That is, at the three solemn feasts:
and undoubtedly at all other appointed times.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p10">26. Made - Not now, but in the beginning of his
reign.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p11">27. Knowledge of the sea - For which the Tyrians were
famous. He sent also ships to join with Solomon's, not from Tyre, the
city of Phoenicia; but from an island in the Red-sea, called Tyre,
because it was a colony of the Tyrians, as Strabo notes.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.x.ii-p12">28. Ophir - A place famous for the plenty and fineness of
the gold there. It is agreed, that it was a part of the East-Indies,
probably Ceylon, which though very remote from us, yet was far nearer
the Red-sea, from whence they might easily sail to it in those ancient
times, because they might (according to the manner of those first ages)
sail all along near the coast, though the voyage was thereby more
tedious, which was the reason why three years were spent in it. And
here, and here only were to be had all the commodities which Solomon
fetched from Ophir, chap. x, 22. Fetched - In all there came to the king
four hundred and fifty talents, whereof it seems thirty talents were
allowed to Hiram and his men, and so there were only four hundred and
twenty that came clear into the king's treasury.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="63.97%" prev="ii.xii.x.ii" next="ii.xii.xi.i" id="ii.xii.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings X" id="ii.xii.xi-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="63.97%" prev="ii.xii.xi" next="ii.xii.xi.ii" id="ii.xii.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xi.i-p1">The queen of Sheba's interview with Solomon, ver. 1-10.
His riches, ver. 11-15. Targets, ivory throne, vessels, ver, 16-23.
Presents, chariots and horses, tribute, ver. 24-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="63.97%" prev="ii.xii.xi.i" next="ii.xii.xii" id="ii.xii.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p1">1. Sheba - Of that part of Arabia, called Shabaea, which
was at great distance from Jerusalem, bordering upon the Southern Sea;
for there, much more than in Ethiopia, were the commodities which she
brought, ver. 2, 10. Name of the Lord - That is, concerning God; the
name of God being often put for God; concerning his deep knowledge in
the things of God. For it is very probable she had, as had divers other
Heathens, some knowledge of the true God, and an earnest desire to know
more concerning him. Questions - Concerning natural, and civil, and
especially, Divine things.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p2">2. All her heart - Of all the doubts and difficulties
wherewith her mind was perplexed.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p3">4. House - Or, the houses, the temple and the king's
house, in both which there were evidences of singular wisdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p4">5. Sitting - The order and manner in which his courtiers,
or other subjects (who all were his servants in a general sense) sat
down at meals, at several tables in his court. Attendance - Upon the
king, both at his table, and in his court; and when he went abroad to
the temple or other places. Apparel - Both the costliness of it, and
especially the agreeableness of it to their several places and offices.
Went up - From his own palace. See <scripRef passage="2 Kings xvi. 18" id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|2Kgs|16|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.16.18">2 Kings xvi, 18</scripRef>, but the ancients, and some others, translate the words
thus, and the burnt-offerings which he offered up in the house of the
Lord; under which, is the chief, all other sacrifices are understood:
when she saw the manner of his offering sacrifices to the Lord; which
doubtless she would not neglect to see; and in the ordering of which she
might discern many characters of excellent wisdom, especially when she
had so excellent an interpreter as Solomon was, to inform her of the
reasons of all the circumstances of that service. No spirit - She was
astonished, and could scarcely determine whether she really saw these
things, or whether it was only a pleasant dream.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p5">8. Happy, &amp;c. - With much more reason may we say this
of Christ's servants: Blessed are they that dwell in thy house: they
will be always praising thee.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p6">14. Six hundred, &amp;c. - Which amounts to about three
millions of our money. And this gold did not come from Ophir in India,
or Tharshish; but from Arabia and Ethiopia, which then were replenished
with gold, though exhausted by the insatiable avarice of succeeding
Ages.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p7">15. Merchant-men - Hebrew. of the searchers; either
merchants, who use to search out commodities: or, the gatherers of the
king's revenues, who used to search narrowly into all wares, that the
king might not be defrauded of his rights. Spice-merchants - Or rather,
of the merchants in general, as the word is often used. So this and the
former particular contain both the branches of the king's revenue, what
he had from the land, and what he had from the merchants and traders.
Kings - Of those parts of Arabia which were next to Canaan, which were
either conquered by David, or submitted to pay tribute to Solomon. But
we must not think all these to be kings of large dominions; many of them
were only governors of cities, and the territories belonging to them,
such as were formerly in Canaan, and were anciently called kings. The
country - Or, of the land; the land of Arabia: whereof some parts were
so far conquered, that he had governors of his own over them, who were
each of them to take care of the king's revenue in his jurisdiction; and
part only so far, that they still had kings of their own, but such as
were tributaries to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p8">16. Targets - For pomp and magnificence, and to be
carried before him, by his guard, when he went abroad. The Roman
magistrates had rods and axes carried before them, in token of their
power to correct the bad: but Solomon shields and targets, to shew he
took more pleasure in his power to defend and protect the good.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p9">17. Shields - Smaller than targets.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p10">19. Round - Made like the half of a circle.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p11">21. Nothing - Comparatively. Such hyperbolical
expressions are frequent both in scripture and other authors. But if
gold in abundance, would make silver seem so despicable, shall not
wisdom and grace, and the foretastes of heaven, make gold seem much more
so?</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p12">22. Tharshish - Ships that went to Tharshish. For
Tharshish was the name of a place upon the sea, famous for its traffick
with merchants, and it was a place very remote from Judea, as appears
from the three years usually spent in that voyage. But whether it was
Spain, where in those times there was abundance of gold and silver, as
Strabo and others affirm; or, some place in the Indies, it is needless
to determine.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p13">24. All the earth - That is, all the kings of the earth,
(as it is expressed <scripRef passage="2 Chron. ix. 23" id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p13.1" parsed="|2Chr|9|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.9.23">2 Chron. ix, 23</scripRef>,) namely of those parts of the earth.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p14">28. Horses, &amp;c. - The two chief commodities of Egypt.
Price - Solomon received them from Pharaoh at a price agreed between
them, and gave this privilege to his merchants, for a tribute to be paid
out of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p15">29. Chariot - This is not to be understood of the
chariots and horses themselves, but for the lading of chariots and
horses, which consisting of fine linen and silk, were of great value:
and the king's custom, together with the charges of the journey,
amounted to these sums. Hittites - A people dwelling principally in the
northern and eastern parts of Canaan, <scripRef passage="Josh. i. 4" id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p15.1" parsed="|Josh|1|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.1.4">Josh. i, 4</scripRef>, whom the Israelites, contrary to their duty, suffered to
live amongst them, <scripRef passage="Judg. iii. 5" id="ii.xii.xi.ii-p15.2" parsed="|Judg|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.3.5">Judg. iii, 5</scripRef>, who afterwards grew numerous and potent, and, it may be,
sent out colonies (after the manner of the ancient times) into some
parts of Syria and Arabia. And possibly, these kings of the Hittites may
be some of those kings of Arabia, ver. 15.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="64.07%" prev="ii.xii.xi.ii" next="ii.xii.xii.i" id="ii.xii.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XI" id="ii.xii.xii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="64.07%" prev="ii.xii.xii" next="ii.xii.xii.ii" id="ii.xii.xii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xii.i-p1">Solomon's many wives turn his heart from God, ver. 1-8.
God reproves and threatens him, ver. 9-13. Stirs up Hadad and Rezon
against him, ver. 14-25. An account of Jeroboam, ver. 26-40. Solomon's
death and burial, ver. 41-43.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="64.07%" prev="ii.xii.xii.i" next="ii.xii.xiii" id="ii.xii.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p1">3. Seven hundred wives, &amp;c. - God had particularly
forbidden the kings to multiply either horses or wives, <scripRef passage="Deut. xvii. 16, 17" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Deut|17|16|17|17" osisRef="Bible:Deut.17.16-Deut.17.17">Deut. xvii, 16, 17</scripRef>, we saw chap.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p2">chap. x, 29, how he broke the former law, multiplying
horses: and here we see, how he broke the latter, multiplying wives.
David set the example. One ill act of a good man may do more mischief
than twenty of a wicked man. Besides, they were strange women, of the
nations which God had expressly forbidden them to marry with. And to
compleat the mischief, he clave unto these in love; was extravagantly
fond of them, Solomon had much knowledge. But to what purpose, when he
knew not how to govern his appetites?</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p3">4. Was old - As having now reigned nigh thirty years.
When it might have been expected that experience would have made him
wiser: then God permitted him to fall so shamefully, that he might be to
all succeeding generations an example of the folly, and weakness of the
wisest and the best men, when left to themselves. Turned his heart - Not
that they changed his mind about the true God, and idols, which is not
credible; but they obtained from him a publick indulgence for their
worship, and possibly persuaded him to join with them in the outward act
of idol-worship; or, at least, in their feasts upon their sacrifices,
which was a participation of their idolatry.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p4">5. Milcom - Called also Moloch.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p5">6. Did evil - That is, did not worship God wholly, but
joined idols with him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p6">7. An high place - That is, an altar upon the high place,
as the manner of the Heathens was. The hill - In the mount of olives,
which was nigh unto Jerusalem, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xv. 30" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|2Sam|15|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.15.30">2 Sam. xv, 30</scripRef>, and from this act was called the mount of corruption, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xxiii. 13" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|2Kgs|23|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.23.13">2 Kings xxiii, 13</scripRef>. As it were, to confront the temple.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p7">8. And sacrificed, &amp;c. - See what need those have to
stand upon their guard, who have been eminent for religion. The devil
will set upon them most violently: and if they miscarry, the reproach is
the greater. It is the evening that commends the day. Let us therefore
fear, lest having run well, we come short.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p8">12. Fathers sake - For my promise made to him, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. vii. 12-15" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|2Sam|7|12|7|15" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.7.12-2Sam.7.15">2 Sam. vii, 12-15</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p9">13. One tribe - Benjamin was not entirely his, but part
of it adhered to Jeroboam, as Bethel, chap. xii, 29, and Hephron, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xiii. 19" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|2Chr|13|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.13.19">2
Chron. xiii, 19</scripRef>, both which were towns of Benjamin.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p10">15. In Edom - By his army, to war against it. To bury -
The Israelites who were slain in the battle, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. viii. 13, 14" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|2Sam|8|13|8|14" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.8.13-2Sam.8.14">2 Sam. viii, 13, 14</scripRef>, whom he honourably interred in some certain place, to which
he is said to go up for that end. And this gave Hadad the opportunity of
making his escape, whilst Joab and his men were employed in that
solemnity. Had smitten - Or, and he smote, as it is in the Hebrew: which
is here noted as the cause of Hadad's flight; he understood what Joab
had done in part, and intended farther to do, even to kill all the males
and therefore fled for his life.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p11">18. Midian - He fled at first with an intent to go into
Egypt, but took Midian, a neighbouring country, in his way, and staid
there a while, possibly 'till he had by some of his servants tried
Pharaoh's mind, and prepared the way for his reception. Paran - Another
country in the road from Edom to Egypt, where he hired men to attend
him, that making his entrance there something like a prince, he might
find more favour from that king and people. Land - To support himself
and his followers out of the profits of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p12">19. Found favour - God so disposing his heart, that Hadad
might be a scourge to Solomon for his impieties.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p13">21. Joab - Whom he feared as much as David himself. Own
country - Whither accordingly he came; and was there, even from the
beginning of Solomon's reign. And it is probable, by the near relation
which was between his wife and Solomon's; and, by Pharaoh's
intercession, he obtained his kingdom with condition of subjection and
tribute to be paid by him to Solomon; which condition he kept 'till
Solomon fell from God, and then began to be troublesome, and dangerous
to his house and kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p14">23. Who fled - When David had defeated him. Zobah - A
part of Syria, between Damascus and Euphrates.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p15">24. A band - Of soldiers, who fled upon that defeat, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. x. 18" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p15.1" parsed="|2Sam|10|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.10.18">2 Sam. x, 18</scripRef>, and others who readily joined them, and lived by robbery;
as many Arabians did. Damascus - And took it, whilst Solomon was
wallowing in luxury.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p16">25. All adversity - He was a secret enemy, all that time;
and when Solomon had forsaken God, he shewed himself openly. Beside -
This infelicity was added to the former; whilst Hadad molested him in
the south, Rezon threatened him in the north. But what hurt could Hadad
or Rezon have done, to so powerful a king as Solomon, if he had not by
sin made himself mean and weak? If God be on our side, we need not fear
the greatest adversary. But if he be against us, he can make us fear the
least: yea, the grasshopper shall be a burden. Syria - Over all that
part of Syria, enlarging his empire the more, and thereby laying a
foundation for much misery to Solomon's kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p17">28. Charge - The taxes and tributes.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p18">29. Went - Probably to execute his charge. Were alone -
Having gone aside for private conference; for otherwise it is most
likely that he had servants attending him, who, though they hear not the
words, yet might see the action, and the rending of Jeroboam's coat; and
thus it came to Solomon's ears, who being so wise, could easily
understand the thing by what he heard of the action, especially when a
prophet did it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p19">39. For this - For this cause, which I mentioned ver. 33.
Not forever - There shall a time come when the seed of David shall not
be molested by the kingdom of Israel, but that kingdom shall be
destroyed, and the kings of the house of David shall be uppermost, as it
was in the days of Asa, Hezekiah and Judah. And at last the Messiah
shall come, who shall unite together the broken sticks of Judah and
Joseph, and rule over all the Jews and Gentiles too.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p20">40. Solomon - To whose ears this had come. Shishak -
Solomon's brother-in-law, who yet might be jealous of him, or alienated
from him, because he had taken so many other wives to his sister, might
cast a greedy eye upon the great riches which Solomon had amassed
together, and upon which, presently after Solomon's death, he laid
violent hands, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xii. 9" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p20.1" parsed="|2Chr|12|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.12.9">2 Chron. xii, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p21">41. The book - In the publick records, where the lives
and actions of kings were registered from time to time, so this was only
a political, not a sacred book.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p22">42. Forty years - His reign was as long as his father's,
but not his life; sin shortened his days.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p23">43. Slept - This expression is promiscuously used
concerning good and bad; and signifies only, that they died as their
fathers did. But did he repent before he died? This seems to be put out
of dispute by the book of Ecclesiastes; written after his fall; as is
evident, not only from the unanimous testimony of the Hebrew writers,
but also, from the whole strain of that book, which was written long
after he had finished all his works, and after he had liberally drunk of
all sorts of sensual pleasures, and sadly experienced the bitter effects
of his love of women, <scripRef passage="Eccles vii. 17" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p23.1" parsed="|Eccl|7|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eccl.7.17">Eccles vii, 17</scripRef>, &amp;c. which makes it more than probable, that as David
writ <scripRef passage="Psalm li. 1-19" id="ii.xii.xii.ii-p23.2" parsed="|Ps|51|1|51|19" osisRef="Bible:Ps.51.1-Ps.51.19">Psalm
li, 1-19</scripRef>. So Solomon wrote this book as a publick testimony and
profession of his repentance.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="64.20%" prev="ii.xii.xii.ii" next="ii.xii.xiii.i" id="ii.xii.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XII" id="ii.xii.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="64.20%" prev="ii.xii.xiii" next="ii.xii.xiii.ii" id="ii.xii.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.i-p1">Rehoboam succeeds and Jeroboam returns out of Egypt, ver.
1, 2. The peoples petition to Rehoboam, and his answer, ver. 3-15. Ten
tribes revolt and make Jeroboam king, ver. 16-20. God forbids Rehoboam
to make war upon them, ver. 21-24. Jeroboam sets up two golden calves,
ver. 25-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="64.21%" prev="ii.xii.xiii.i" next="ii.xii.xiv" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p1">1. Were come - Rehoboam did not call them thither, but
went thither, because the Israelites prevented him, and had pitched upon
that place, rather than upon Jerusalem, because it was most convenient
for all, being in the center of the kingdom; and because that being in
the potent tribe of Ephraim, they supposed there they might use that
freedom of speech, which they resolved to use, to get there grievances
redressed. So out of a thousand wives and concubines, he had but one son
to bear his name, and he a fool! Is not sin an ill way of building up a
family?</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p2">3. They sent - When the people sent him word of Solomon's
death, they also sent a summons for him to come to Shechem. That the
presence and countenance of a man of so great interest and reputation,
might lay the greater obligation upon Rehoboam to grant them ease and
relief.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p3">4. Grievous - By heavy taxes and impositions, not only
for the temple and his magnificent buildings, but for the expenses of
his numerous court, and of so many wives and concubines. And Solomon
having so grossly forsaken God, it is no wonder if he oppressed the
people.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p4">7. This day - By complying with their desires, and
condescending to them for a season, till thou art better established in
thy throne. They use this expression, fore-seeing that some would
dissuade him from this course, as below the majesty of a prince. And
answer - Thy service is not hard, it is only a few good words, which it
is as easy to give as bad ones.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p5">8. Young men - So called, comparatively to the old men:
otherwise they were near forty years old.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p6">10. Shall be thicker - Or rather, is thicker, and
therefore stronger, and more able to crush you, if you proceed in these
mutinous demands, than his loins, in which is the principal seat of
strength.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p7">15. From the Lord - Who gave up Rehoboam to so foolish
and fatal a mistake, and alienated the peoples affections from him; and
ordered all circumstances by his wise providence to that end.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p8">16. In David - In David's family and son; we can expect
no benefit or relief from him, and therefore we renounce all commerce
with him, and subjection to him. They named David, rather than Rehoboam;
to signify, that they renounced not Rehoboam only, but all David's
family. Son of Jesse - So they call David in contempt; as if they had
said, Rehoboam hath no reason to carry himself with such pride and
contempt toward his people; for if we trace his original, it was as mean
and obscure as any of ours. To your tents - Let us forsake him, and go
to our own homes, there to consider, how to provide for ourselves.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p9">17. Judah - The tribe of Judah; with those parts of the
tribes of Levi, and Simeon, and Benjamin, whose dwellings were within
the confines of Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p10">18. Sent Adoram - Probably to pursue the counsel which he
had resolved upon, to execute his office, and exact their tribute with
rigor and violence, if need were.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p11">19. Rebelled - Their revolt was sinful, as they did not
this in compliance with God's counsel, but to gratify their own
passions.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p12">20. Was come - From Egypt; which was known to them before
who met at Shechem, and now by all the people. Was none - That is, no
entire tribe.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p13">24. From me - This event is from my counsel and
providence, to punish Solomon's apostasy.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p14">25. Shechem - He repaired, and enlarged, and fortified
it; for it had been ruined long since, <scripRef passage="Judg. ix. 45" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Judg|9|45|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.9.45">Judg. ix, 45</scripRef>. He might chuse it as a place both auspicious, because here
the foundation of his monarchy was laid; and commodious, as being near
the frontiers of his kingdom. Penuel - A place beyond Jordan; to secure
that part of his dominions.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p15">26. Said, &amp;c. - Reasoned within himself. The phrase
discovers the fountain of his error, that he did not consult with God,
who had given him the kingdom; as in all reason, and justice, and
gratitude he should have done: nor believed God's promise, chap. xi, 38,
but his own carnal policy.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p16">27. Will turn - Which in itself might seem a prudent
conjecture; for this would give Rehoboam, and the priests, and Levites,
the sure and faithful friends of David's house, many opportunities of
alienating their minds from him, and reducing them to their former
allegiance. But considering God's providence, by which the hearts of all
men, and the affairs of all kingdoms are governed, and of which he had
lately seen so eminent an instance; it was a foolish, as well as wicked
course.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p17">28. Calves - In imitation of Aaron's golden calf, and of
the Egyptians, from whom he was lately come. And this he the rather
presumed to do, because he knew the people of Israel were generally
prone to idolatry: and that Solomon's example had exceedingly
strengthened those inclinations; and therefore they were prepared for
such an attempt; especially, when his proposition tended to their own
ease, and safety, and profit, which he knew was much dearer to them, as
well as to himself, than their religion. Too much - Too great a trouble
and charge, and neither necessary, nor safe for them, as things now
stood. Behold thy gods - Not as if he thought to persuade the people,
that these calves were that very God of Israel, who brought them out of
Egypt: which was so monstrously absurd and ridiculous, that no Israelite
in his right wits could believe it, and had been so far from satisfying
his people, that this would have made him both hateful, and contemptible
to them; but his meaning was, that these Images were visible
representations, by which he designed to worship the true God of Israel,
as appears, partly from that parallel place, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxii. 4" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Exod|32|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.32.4">Exod. xxxii, 4</scripRef>, partly, because the priests and worshippers of the calves,
are said to worship Jehovah; and upon that account, are distinguished
from those belonging to Baal, chap. xviii, 21, xxii, 6, 7, and partly,
from Jeroboam's design in this work, which was to quiet the peoples
minds, and remove their scruples about going to Jerusalem to worship
their God in that place, as they were commanded: which he doth, by
signifying to them, that he did not intend any alteration in the
substance of their religion; nor to draw them from the worship of the
true God, to the worship of any of those Baals, which were set up by
Solomon; but to worship that self-same God whom they worshipped in
Jerusalem, even the true God, who brought them out of Egypt; only to
vary a circumstance: and that as they worshipped God at Jerusalem,
before one visible sign, even the ark, and the sacred cherubim there; so
his subjects should worship God by another visible sign, even that of
the calves, in other places; and as for the change of the place, he
might suggest to them, that God was present in all places, where men
with honest minds called upon him; that before the temple was built, the
best of kings, and prophets, and people, did pray, and sacrifice to God
in divers high places, without any scruple. And that God would dispense
with them also in that matter; because going to Jerusalem was dangerous
to them at this time; and God would have mercy, rather than
sacrifice.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p18">29. Beth-el, &amp;c. - Which two places he chose for his
peoples conveniency; Beth-el being in the southern, and Dan. in the
northern parts of his kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p19">30. A sin - That is, an occasion of great wickedness, not
only of idolatry, which is called sin by way of eminency; nor only of
the worship of the calves, wherein they pretended to worship the true
God; but also of the worship of Baal, and of the utter desertion of the
true God; and of all sorts of impiety. To Daniel - Which is not here
mentioned exclusively, for they went also to Beth-el, ver. 32, 33, but
for other reasons, either because that of Daniel was first made, the
people in those parts having been long leavened with idolatry, <scripRef passage="Judg. xviii. 30" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p19.1" parsed="|Judg|18|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.18.30">Judg. xviii, 30</scripRef>, or to shew the peoples readiness and zeal for idols; that
those who lived in, or near Beth-el, had not patience to stay 'till that
calf was finished, but all of them were forward to go as far as Daniel,
which was in the utmost borders of the land, to worship an idol there;
when it was thought too much for them to go to Jerusalem to worship
God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p20">31. An house - Houses, or chapels, besides the temples,
which are built at Daniel and Beth-el; he built also for his peoples
better accommodation, lesser temples upon divers high places. Of the
lowest - Which he might do, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p21">1. because the better sort refused it,
or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p22">2. because such would be satisfied with
mean allowances; and so he could put into his own purse a great part of
the revenues of the Levites, which doubtless he seized upon when they
forsook him, and went to Jerusalem, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xi. 13, 14" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p22.1" parsed="|2Chr|11|13|11|14" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.11.13-2Chr.11.14">2 Chron. xi, 13, 14</scripRef>, or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p23">3. because mean persons would depend upon
his favour, and therefore be pliable to his humour, and firm to his
interest, but the words in the Hebrew properly signify, from the ends of
the people; which may be translated thus, out of all the people;
promiscuously out of every tribe. Which exposition seems to be confirmed
by the following words, added to explain these, which were not of the
sons of Levi; though they were not of the tribe of Levi. And that indeed
was Jeroboam's sin; not that he chose mean persons, for some of the
Levites were such; and his sin had not been less, if he had chosen the
noblest and greatest persons; as we see in the example of Uzziah. But
that he chose men of other tribes, contrary to God's appointment, which
restrained that office to that tribe. Levi - To whom that office was
confined by God's express command.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p24">32. A feast - The feast of tabernacles. So he would keep
God's feast, not in God's time, which was the fifteenth day of the
seventh month, and so onward, <scripRef passage="Levit xxiii. 34" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p24.1" parsed="|Lev|23|34|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.23.34">Levit xxiii, 34</scripRef>, but on the fifteenth day of the eighth month. And this
alteration he made, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p25">1. to keep up the difference between his
subjects, and those of Judah as by the differing manners, so by the
distinct times of their worship. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p26">2. lest he should seem directly to oppose
the God of Israel, (who had in a special manner obliged all the people
to go up to Jerusalem at that time,) by requiring their attendance to
celebrate the feast elsewhere, at the same time. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p27">3. to engage as many persons as possibly he
could, to come to his feast; which they would more willingly do when the
feast at Jerusalem was past and all the fruits of the earth were
perfectly gathered in. Fifteenth day - And so onward till the seven days
ended. Like that in Judah - He took his pattern thence, to shew, that he
worshipped the same God, and professed the same religion for substance,
which they did: howsoever he differed in circumstances. He offered -
Either,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p28">1. by his priests. Or, rather,</p>

<p class="List4" id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p29">2. by his own hands; as appears from chap.
xiii, 1, 4, which he did, to give the more countenance to his
new-devised solemnity. Nor is this strange; for he might plausibly
think, that he who by his own authority had made others priests might
much more exercise a part of that office; at least, upon an
extraordinary occasion; in which case, he knew David himself had done
some things, which otherwise he might not do. So he did - He himself did
offer there in like manner, as he now had done at Dan.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiii.ii-p30">33. Devised - Which he appointed without any warrant from
God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="64.40%" prev="ii.xii.xiii.ii" next="ii.xii.xiv.i" id="ii.xii.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XIII" id="ii.xii.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="64.40%" prev="ii.xii.xiv" next="ii.xii.xiv.ii" id="ii.xii.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.i-p1">A prophet threatens Jeroboam's altar, and gives a sign,
which immediately comes to pass, ver, 1-5. He restores Jeroboam's
withered hand, and leaves Bethel, ver. 6-10. The old prophet deceives
and entertains him, ver. 11-19. He is threatened with death, ver. 20-23.
Slain by a lion and buried, ver. 24-32. Jeroboam is hardened in his
idolatry, ver. 33, 34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="64.41%" prev="ii.xii.xiv.i" next="ii.xii.xv" id="ii.xii.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p1">1. Man of God - An holy prophet. By the word, &amp;c. -
By Divine inspiration and command.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p2">2. The altar - And consequently, against all that
worship. O altar - He directs his speech to the altar, because the
following signs were wrought upon it. Josiah - Which being done above
three hundred years after this prophecy, plainly shews the absolute
certainty of God's providence; and fore-knowledge even in the most
contingent things. For this was in itself uncertain, and wholly depended
upon man's will, both as to the having of a child, and as to the giving
it this name. Therefore God can certainly and effectually over-rule
man's will which way he pleaseth; or else it was possible, that this
prediction should have been false; which is blasphemous to imagine. The
priests - The bones of the priests, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xxiii. 15, 16" id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Kgs|23|15|23|16" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.23.15-2Kgs.23.16">2
Kings xxiii, 15, 16</scripRef>, whereby the altar should be defiled. How bold was the man,
that durst attack the king in his pride, and interrupt the solemnity he
was proud of? Whoever is sent on God's errand, must not fear the faces
of men. It was above three hundred and fifty years ere this prophecy was
fulfilled. Yet it is spoken of as sure and nigh at hand. For a thousand
years are with God as one day.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p3">3. Gave a sign - That is, he then wrought a miracle, to
assure them of the truth of his prophecy.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p4">4. Put forth, &amp;c. - To point out the man whom he
would have the people lay hands on. The altar - Where it was employed in
offering something upon it. Dried up - Or, withered, the muscles and
sinews, the instruments of motion, shrunk up. This God did, to chastise
Jeroboam for offering violence to the Lord's prophet: to secure the
prophet against farther violence: and, that in this example God might
shew, how highly he resents the injuries done to his ministers, for the
faithful discharge of their office.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p5">6. Thy God - Who hath manifested himself to be thy God
and friend, in a singular manner; and therefore will hear thy prayers
for me, though he will not regard mine, because I have forsaken him and
his worship. Besought - To assure Jeroboam, that what he had said, was
not from ill-will to him, and that he heartily desired his reformation,
and not his ruin. Restored - Because he repented of that violence, which
he intended against that prophet, for which God inflicted it: and that
this goodness of God to him, might have led him to repentance; or, if he
continued impenitent, leave him without excuse.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p6">9. For so, &amp;c. - My refusal of thy favour, is not
from any contempt, or hatred of thy person; but in obedience to the just
command of my God, who hath forbidden me all father converse or
communication with thee. Eat nor drink - In that place, or with that
people. Whereby God declares, how detestable they were in God's eyes;
because they were vile apostates from the true God, and embraced this
idol-worship, against the light of their own consciences, merely to
comply with the king's humour and command. Nor turn - That by thy
avoiding the way that led thee to Beth-el as execrable, although thou
wentest by my special command, thou mightest teach all others, how much
they should abhor that way, and all thoughts of going to that place, or
to such people, upon any unnecessary occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p7">11. A prophet - One to whom, and by whom God did
sometimes impart his mind; as it is manifest from ver. 20, 21, and one
that had a respect to the Lord's holy prophets, and gave credit to their
predictions: but whether he was a good man, may be doubted, seeing we
find him in a downright lie, ver. 18. And altho' an holy prophet may
possibly have continued in the kingdom of Israel, he would never have
gone from his own habitation, to dwell at Beth- el, the chief seat of
idolatry, unless with design to preach against it: which it is evident
he did not; his sons seem to have been present at, and, and to have
joined with others in that idolatrous worship.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p8">21. Cried - With a loud voice, the effect of his passion,
both for his own guilt and shame, and for the prophet's approaching
misery.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p9">22. Shall not, &amp;c. - Thou shalt not die a natural,
but a violent death; and that in this journey, before thou returnest to
thy native habitation. But is it not strange that the lying prophet
escapes, while the man of God is so severely punished? Certainly there
must be a judgment to come, when these things shall be called over
again, and when those who sinned most and suffered least in this world,
will receive according to their works.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p10">23. Saddled for him - But, it is observable, he doth not
accompany him; his guilty conscience making him fear to be involved in
the same judgment with him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p11">24. Slew him - "But why doth God punish a good man so
severely for so small an offense?" His sin was not small, for it was a
gross disobedience to a positive command. And it cannot seem strange if
God should bring his deserved death upon him in this manner, for the
accomplishment of his own glorious designs, to vindicate his own justice
from the imputation of partiality; to assure the truth of his
predictions, and thereby provoke Jeroboam and his idolatrous followers
to repentance; and to justify himself in all his dreadful judgments
which he intended to inflict upon Jeroboam's house, and the whole
kingdom of Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p12">28. He found, &amp;c. - Here was a concurrence of
miracles: that the ass did not run away from the lion, according to his
nature, but boldly stood still, as reserving himself to carry the
prophet to his burial; that the lion did not devour its prey, nor yet go
away when he had done his work, but stood still, partly to preserve the
carcase of the prophet from other wild beasts or fowls, partly, as an
evidence that the prophet's death was not casual, nor the effect of a
lion's ravenous disposition, but of God's singular and just judgment;
and consequently, that his prediction was divine, and should be
infallibly accomplished in its proper time; and partly, as a token of
God's favour to the deceased prophet, of whose very carcase he took such
special care: thereby signifying, that although for wise and just
reasons he thought fit to take away his life, yet his remains was
precious to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p13">30. His grave - So that threatening, ver. 22, was
fulfilled; and withal, the memory of his prophecy was revived and
preserved among them, and his very carcase resting there, might be a
witness of their madness and desperate wickedness, in continuing in
their abominable idolatry, after such an assurance of the dreadful
effects of it. They - The old prophet and his sons, and others, whom
common humanity taught to lament the untimely death of so worthy a
person. Alas, &amp;c. - Which was an usual form of expression in
funeral-Lamentations.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p14">31. When I am dead,&amp;c. - Tho' he was a lying prophet,
yet he desired to die the death of a true prophet. Gather not my Soul
with the sinners of Beth-el, but with this man of God: Because what he
cried against the altar of Beth-el, shall surely come to pass. Thus by
the mouth of two witnesses was it established, if possible to convince
Jeroboam.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p15">32. Samaria - That is, of the kingdom of Samaria; as it
was called, though not when this fact was done, yet before these books
were written. Samaria was properly this name of one city, chap. xxi, 1,
but from hence the whole kingdom of Israel was so called.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p16">33. After this - That is, after all these things: the
singular number put for the plural; after so many, and evident, and
successive miracles. Made again - He abated not so much as a
circumstance in his idolatrous worship. Whosoever - Without any respect
to tribe or family, or integrity of body, or mind, or life; all which
were to be regarded in the priesthood.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xiv.ii-p17">34. Sin - Either, an occasion of sin, and means of
hardening all his posterity in their idolatry: or, a punishment, for so
the word sin is often used. This his obstinate continuance in his
idolatry, after such warnings, was the utter ruin of all his family.
They betray themselves effectually, who endeavour to support themselves
by any sin.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="64.55%" prev="ii.xii.xiv.ii" next="ii.xii.xv.i" id="ii.xii.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XIV" id="ii.xii.xv-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="64.55%" prev="ii.xii.xv" next="ii.xii.xv.ii" id="ii.xii.xv.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xv.i-p1">Jeroboam sends to the prophet, to inquire concerning his
sick son, ver. 1-6. The destruction of Jeroboam's household told, ver.
7-16. The death of his child, ver. 17, 18. The conclusion of his reign,
ver. 19, 20. The declension of Rehoboam's house and kingdom, ver. 21-28.
The conclusion of his reign, ver. 28-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="64.56%" prev="ii.xii.xv.i" next="ii.xii.xvi" id="ii.xii.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p1">1. At that time - Presently after the things described in
the former chapter; which, though related in the beginning of his reign,
yet might be done a good while after it, and so Ahijah the prophet might
be very old, as he is described to be ver. 4. It is probable he was his
eldest son.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p2">2. His wife - Because she might without suspicion inquire
concerning her own child; and because she would inquire exactly, and
diligently, and faithfully acquaint him with the truth. Disguise -
Change thy habit, and voice, and go like a private and obscure person.
This caution proceeded: first, from the pride of his heart, which made
him loth to confess his folly in worshipping such helpless idols, and to
give glory to the God whom he had forsaken. Secondly, from jealousy and
suspicion, lest the prophet knowing this, should either give her no
answer, or make it worse than indeed it was. Thirdly, from policy, lest
his people should by his example be drawn to forsake the calves, and to
return to the God of Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p3">3. And take - A present, after the manner, but mean, as
became an ordinary country woman, which she personated. It had been more
pious to inquire, why God contended with him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p4">6. Thou wife - By which discovery he both reproves their
folly, who thought to conceal themselves from God, and withal gives her
assurance of the truth, and certainty of that message which he was to
deliver. 8. David - Who though he fell into some sins, yet, first, he
constantly persevered in the true worship of God; from which thou art
revolted. Secondly, he heartily repented of, and turned from all his
sins whereas thou art obstinate and incorrigible.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p5">9. Above all - Above all the former kings of my people,
as Saul, and Solomon, and Rehoboam. Images - Namely the golden calves:
not as if they thought them to be other gods in a proper sense; for it
is apparent they still pretended to worship the God of their fathers,
but because God rejected their whole worship, and, howsoever they
accounted it, he reckoned it a manifest defection from him, and a
betaking themselves to other gods, or devils, as they are called, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xi. 15" id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p5.1" parsed="|2Chr|11|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.11.15">2 Chron. xi, 15</scripRef>, whom alone they served and worshipped therein, whatsoever
pretenses they had to the contrary. To provoke - Whereby thou didst
provoke me. For otherwise this was not Jeroboam's design in it, but only
to establish himself in the throne. Hast cast - Despised and forsaken
me, and my commands, and my worship, as we do things which we cast
behind our backs.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p6">10. Shut up - Those who had escaped the fury of their
enemies invading them, either because they were shut up in caves, or
castles, or strong towns, or, because they were left, over-looked or
neglected by them, or spared as poor, impotent, helpless creatures. But
now, saith he, they shall be all searched out, and brought to
destruction. Dung - Which they remove, as a loathsome thing, out of
their houses, and that throughly and universally.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p7">11. Eat - So both sorts shall die unburied.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p8">12. When, &amp;c. - Presently upon thy entrance into the
city; when thou art gone but a little way in it, even as far as to the
threshold of the king's door, ver. 17, which possibly was near the gates
of the city. And by this judge of the truth of the rest of my
prophecy.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p9">13. Shall mourn - For the loss of so worthy and hopeful a
person, and for the sad calamities which will follow his death, which
possibly his moderation, and wisdom, and virtue, might have prevented.
So they should mourn, not simply for him, but for their own loss in him.
Grave - Shall have the honour of burial. Some good - Pious intentions of
taking away the calves, and of permitting or obliging his people to go
up to Jerusalem to worship, if God gave him life and authority to do it,
and of trusting God with his kingdom. In the house - Which is added for
his greater commendation; he was good in the midst of so many
temptations and wicked examples; a good branch of a bad flock.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p10">14. A king - Baasha, chap. xv, 28. That day - When he is
so raised; in the very beginning of his reign, chap. xv, 29. But what? -
But what do I say, he shall raise, as it were a thing to be done at a
great distance of time: the man is now in being if not in power, who
shall do this: this judgment shall be shortly executed. Sometimes God
makes quick work with sinners. He did so with the house of Jeroboam. It
was not twenty four years from his first elevation, to the final
extirpation of his family.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p11">15. Is shaken - Hither and thither, with every wind. So
shall the kingdom and people of Israel be always in an unquiet and
unsettled posture, tossed to and fro by foreign invasions and civil
wars; by opposite kings and factions, and by the dissensions of the
people. The river - Euphrates, so called by way of eminency, this was
accomplished in part <scripRef passage="2 Kings xv. 29" id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p11.1" parsed="|2Kgs|15|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.15.29">2 Kings xv, 29</scripRef>, and more fully, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xvii. 6" id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p11.2" parsed="|2Kgs|17|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.17.6">2 Kings
xvii, 6</scripRef>. Groves - For the worship of their idols, God having before
condemned the making and worshipping of the calves, by which they
pretended to worship the true God; he now takes notice that they were
not contented with the calves, but (as it is in the nature of idolatry,
and all sin, to proceed from evil to worse) were many of them fallen
into a worse kind of idolatry, even their worship of the heathenish
Baals, which they commonly exercised in groves.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p12">16. Who made, &amp;c. - By his invention, and making the
occasion of their sin, the calves; by his example, encouraging those and
only those that worshipped the calves; and by his authority requiring
and compelling them to do it. This is mentioned as a monstrous
aggravation of his wickedness, that he was not content with his own sin,
but was the great author of drawing others into sin, and of corrupting
and undoing the whole kingdom, which therefore God would never forgive
him, but upon all occasions mentions him with this eternal brand of
infamy upon him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p13">17. Tirzah - An ancient and royal city, in a pleasant
place, where the kings of Israel had a palace, whither Jeroboam was now
removed from Shechem, either for his pleasure, or for his son's
recovery, by the healthfulness of the place. The threshold - Of the
king's house, which probably was upon, or by the wall of the city, and
near the gate.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p14">18. Mourned - And justly: not only for the loss of an
hopeful prince, but because his death plucked up the floodgates, at
which an inundation of judgments broke in.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p15">19. The chronicles - not that canonical book of
chronicles; for that was written long after this book: but a book of
civil records, the annals, wherein all remarkable passages were recorded
by the king's command from day to day; out of which the sacred penman by
the direction of God's spirit, took those passages which were most
useful for God's honour, and mens edification.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p16">21. Forty one years - Therefore he was born a year before
Solomon was king, as appears from chap. xi, 42, this is noted as an
aggravation of Rehoboam's folly, that he was old enough to have been
wiser. An Ammonitess - A people cursed by God, and shut out of the
congregation of his people forever. This is observed as one cause both
of God's displeasure in punishing Solomon with such a son, and of
Rehoboam's apostacy after his three first years, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xi. 17" id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p16.1" parsed="|2Chr|11|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.11.17">2 Chron. xi, 17</scripRef>. None can imagine how fatal and how lasting are the
consequence of being unequally yoked with an unbeliever.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p17">22. In the sight of the Lord - In contempt and defiance
of him, and the tokens of his special presence. Jealousy - As the
adulterous wife provokes her husband, by breaking the marriage
covenant.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p18">23. They also - Followed the example of the Israelites,
although they were better instructed, and had the temple in their
kingdom, and liberty of access to it, and the privilege of worshipping
God in his own way, and the counsels, and sermons, and examples of the
priests and Levites, and the dreadful example of Israel's horrid
apostacy, to caution and terrify them. High places - Which was unlawful,
and, now especially when the temple was built, and ready to receive
them; unnecessary, and therefore expressed a greater contempt of God and
his express command. Groves - Not only after the manner of the Heathens
and Israelites, but against a direct and particular prohibition. Under
every green tree - The people were universally corrupted: which is
prodigious, all things considered, and is a clear evidence of the
greatness and depth of the original corruption of man's nature.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p19">24. Abomination - They dishonoured God by one sin, and
then God left them to dishonour themselves by another.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p20">25. Fifth year - Presently after his and his people's
apostacy, which was not 'till his fourth year: while apostate, Israel
enjoyed peace and some kind of prosperity, of which difference, two
reasons may be given: first, Judah's sins were committed against clearer
light, and more powerful means and remedies of all sorts, and therefore
deserved more severe and speedy judgments. Secondly, God discovered more
love to Judah in chastizing them speedily, that they might be humbled,
reformed, and preserved, as it happened; and more anger against Israel,
whom he spared to that total destruction which he intended to bring upon
them. Sishak - He is thought to be Solomon's brother-in-law. But how
little such relations signify among princes, when their interest is
concerned, all histories witness. Besides Rehoboam was not Solomon's son
by Pharaoh's daughter and so the relation was in a manner extinct. Came
up - Either, from a desire to enlarge his empire: or, by Jeroboam's
instigation: or from a covetous desire of possessing those great
treasures which David and Solomon had left: and above all, by God's
providence, disposing his heart to this expedition for Rehoboam's
punishment.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p21">26. He took - First the city: which may seem strange,
considering the great strength of it, and how much time it took
Nebuchadnezzar and Titus to take it. But, first, it might cost Shishak
also a long siege though that be not here related. Secondly, it is
probable David and Solomon in their building and altering the city, had
more respect to state and magnificence than to its defense, as having no
great cause to fear the invasion of any enemies. And it is certain, that
after the division between Judah and Israel, the kings of Judah added
very much to the fortifications of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p22">27. Brazen shields - This was an emblem of the diminution
of his glory. Sin makes the gold become dim, it changes the most fine
gold and turns it into brass.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p23">28. To the house, &amp;c. - By which it seems the
affliction had done him some good, and brought him back to the worship
of God, which he had forsaken.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p24">30. Was war - Not an invasive war with potent armies,
which was forbidden, chap. xii, 24, and not revived 'till Abijam's
reign, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xiii. 1-3" id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p24.1" parsed="|2Chr|13|1|13|3" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.13.1-2Chr.13.3">2
Chron. xiii, 1-3</scripRef>, but a defensive war from those hostilities which by small
parties and skirmishes they did to one another.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xv.ii-p25">31. An Ammonitess - This is repeated as a thing very
observable.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="64.75%" prev="ii.xii.xv.ii" next="ii.xii.xvi.i" id="ii.xii.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XV" id="ii.xii.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="64.75%" prev="ii.xii.xvi" next="ii.xii.xvi.ii" id="ii.xii.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.i-p1">The reigns of Abijam and Asa over Judah, ver. 1-24. Of
Nadab and Baasha over Israel, ver. 25-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="64.75%" prev="ii.xii.xvi.i" next="ii.xii.xvii" id="ii.xii.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p1">1. Abijam reigned - So his reign began with Jeroboam's
eighteenth year, continued his whole nineteenth year, and ended within
his twentieth year, in which also Asa's reign began. And thus one and
the same year may be attributed to two several persons.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p2">2. Three years - That is, part of three years. Abishalom
- Or, of Absalom, as he is called <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xi. 21" id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Chr|11|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.11.21">2 Chron. xi, 21</scripRef>. And because he is here mentioned as a known person, without
any addition of his kindred or quality, some conceive that this was
Absalom's daughter, called properly Tamar, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xiv. 27" id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p2.2" parsed="|2Sam|14|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.14.27">2 Sam. xiv, 27</scripRef>, and from her royal grandmother, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. iii. 3" id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p2.3" parsed="|2Sam|3|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.3.3">2 Sam. iii, 3</scripRef>, Maacah.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p3">4. A lamp - A son and successor to perpetuate his name
and memory, which otherwise had gone into obscurity. Jerusalem - That he
might maintain that city, and temple, and worship, as a witness for God,
in the world, against the Israelites and heathen world.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p4">5. Save only - This and the like phrases are not to be
understood as exclusive of every sinful action, hut only of an habitual
and continued apostasy from God, as the very phrase of turning aside
from God, or from his commands, doth constantly imply. And thus it is
most true. For David's other sins were either sudden and transient acts,
soon repented of and blotted out, as in the cases of Nabal and Achish;
or, mistakes of his judgment, which was not fully convinced of the
sinfulness of such actions: whereas that which concerned Uriah's wife
was a designed and studied sin, long continued in, defended with a
succession of other sins, presumptuous, and scandalous to his
government, and to the true religion.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p5">6. War between, &amp;c. - Upon Jeroboam's invading him
with a great army: acting then in his own defense, he totally routed
Jeroboam, so that he was quiet the rest of his reign.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p6">10. Mother's - That is, his grandmother's, as appears
from ver. 2, who is called his mother, as David is called Abijam's
father, ver. 3. And his grand-mother's name may be here mentioned,
rather than his mother's, because his mother was either an obscure
person, or was dead, or unwilling to take care of the education of her
son, and so he was educated by the grand-mother, who, though she
poisoned his father Abijam with her idolatrous principles, ver. 12, yet
could not infect Asa, nor withhold him from prosecuting his good
purposes of reforming religion.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p7">11. Right - As to the government of his kingdom, and the
reformation, and establishment of God's worship. That is right indeed
which is so in God's eyes. Those are approved whom he commendeth.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p8">12. Sodomites - All whom he could find out; but some
escaped his observation, as appears from chap. xxii, 46. Idols, &amp;c.
- And if his father had made them, he had the more need to remove them,
that he might cut off the entail of the curse.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p9">13. He removed - He took from her either the name and
authority of queen regent, which she, having been Rehoboam's wife, and
Abijam's mother, took to herself during Asa's minority; or, the dignity
of the queen mother, and those guards, or instruments of power, which
she had enjoyed and misemployed. An Idol - Hebrew. a terror, or horror,
that is, an horrible idol; which it may be so called, because it was of
a more terrible shape than ordinary, and not to be seen without horror.
Kidron - That when it was burnt to powder, it might be thrown into the
water, and be unfit for any use.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p10">14. High places - <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xiv. 3" id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|2Chr|14|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.14.3">2 Chron. xiv, 3</scripRef>. He took away the altars of the strange gods, and the high
places where they were worshipped: but as for those high places where
the true God was worshipped he did not take them away; partly, because
he thought there was no great evil in them, which had been used by David
and Solomon, and other good men; partly, because he thought the removal
of them might do more hurt than their continuance, by occasioning the
total neglect of God's worship by many of the people, who either could
not, or, through want of faith and zeal, would not go up to Jerusalem to
worship, now especially, when the Israelites, formerly their friends,
were become their enemies, and watched all opportunities to invade or
molest them. Was perfect - That is, he sincerely and constantly adhered
to the worship of God. Though he could not hinder the people from using
the high places, yet he entirely devoted himself to the worship of God
in the manner and place prescribed by him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p11">15. His father - Abijam, when he was in distress, and
going to fight with Jeroboam, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xiii. 1-3" id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p11.1" parsed="|2Chr|13|1|13|3" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.13.1-2Chr.13.3">2 Chron. xiii, 1-3</scripRef>, though afterwards he did not perform his vows, nor bring in
what he had devoted; probably he was prevented by death.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p12">17. Built - That is, repaired and fortified.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p13">18. Were left - What either Shishak had left, or Abijam,
or Asa, or others, both of Israel or Judah had dedicated; which probably
was not inconsiderable, because Asa had got great spoils from Zerah, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xiv. 9-15" id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p13.1" parsed="|2Chr|14|9|14|15" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.14.9-2Chr.14.15">2 Chron. xiv, 9-15</scripRef>, and he and his numerous and prosperous people, did at this
time express a great zeal for the house and worship of God. Sent them -
Wherein he committed three great faults, amongst many others, first, he
alienated things consecrated to God, without necessity. Secondly, he did
this out of distrust of that God whose power and goodness he had lately
experienced. Thirdly, he did this for an ill intent, to hire him to the
breach of his league and covenant with Baasha, ver. 19, and to take away
part of that land which by right, and the special gift of God, belonged
to the Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p14">21. Tirzah - Now the royal city of Israel. There he abode
to defend his own kingdoms, and durst not return to oppose Asa, lest the
Syrian king should make a second invasion. So Asa met with success in
this ungodly course as good men sometimes meet with disappointment in a
good cause and course. So there is no judging of causes by events.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p15">22. None, &amp;c. - All sorts of persons were obliged to
come, except those who were disabled by age, or infirmity, or absence,
or by the public service of the king and kingdom in other places. Built
- Repaired and strengthened them, for they were built before.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p16">23. Nevertheless - Notwithstanding the great things which
he had done, and the glory and prosperity which he enjoyed, he felt the
effects of human infirmity, and of his own sins.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p17">25. Two years - Not compleat, as appears from ver. 28,
33.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p18">26. In his sin - In the worship of the calves which his
father had made.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p19">28. Even, &amp;c. - It was threatened, chap. xiv, 15,
that Israel should be as a reed shaken in the water. And so they were,
when, during the single reign of Asa, their government was in seven or
eight different hands. Jeroboam was upon the throne at the beginning of
his reign, and Ahab at the end of it: between whom were Nadab, Baashah,
Elah, Zimri, Tibni, and Omri, undermining and destroying one another.
This they got by deserting the house both of God and of David.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p20">29. Any - Any of the males of that family. According,
&amp;c. - So God overruled Baasha's ambition and cruelty, to fulfil his
own prediction.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvi.ii-p21">30. Because - So that same wicked policy which he used to
establish the kingdom in his family, proved his and their ruin: which is
very frequently the event of ungodly counsels.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="64.87%" prev="ii.xii.xvi.ii" next="ii.xii.xvii.i" id="ii.xii.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XVI" id="ii.xii.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="64.88%" prev="ii.xii.xvii" next="ii.xii.xvii.ii" id="ii.xii.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.i-p1">The ruin of Baasha's family foretold, ver. 1-7. And
executed by Zimri, ver. 8-14. Zimri's short reign, ver. 15-20. The
struggle between Omri and Tibni, and Omri's reign, ver. 21-28. The
beginning of Ahab's reign, ver. 29-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="64.88%" prev="ii.xii.xvii.i" next="ii.xii.xviii" id="ii.xii.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p1">1. Hanani - He was sent to Asa, king of Judah. But the
son, who was young and more active, was sent on this longer and more
dangerous expedition to Baasha, king of Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p2">2. I made thee - Though that invading the kingdom was
from himself, and his own wicked heart; yet the translation of the
kingdom from Nadab to Baasha simply considered, was from God, who by his
providence disposed of all occasions, and of the hearts of the soldiers
and people, so that Baasha should have opportunity of executing God's
judgment upon Nadab; nay, the very act of Baasha, the killing his master
Nadab, was an act of divine justice. And if Baasha had done this in
obedience to God's command, and with a single design, to execute God's
vengeance threatened against him, it had been no more a sin, than Jehu's
act in killing his master king Jehoram, upon the same account, <scripRef passage="2 Kings ix. 24" id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Kgs|9|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.9.24">2
Kings ix, 24</scripRef>. But Baasha did this, merely to gratify his own pride, or
covetousness, or malice, ver. 7.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p3">7. Came, &amp;c. - The meaning is, the message which came
from the Lord to Jehu, ver. 1, &amp;c. was here delivered by the hand,
the ministry of Jehu, unto Baasha. Jehu did what God commanded him in
this matter, tho' it was not without apparent hazard to himself.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p4">8. Two years - One compleat, and part of the other, ver.
10.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p5">9. Chariots - Of all his military chariots, and the men
belonging to them: the chariots for carriage of necessary things, being
put into meaner hands. Tirzah - Whilst his forces were elsewhere
employed, ver. 15, which gave Zimri advantage to execute his design.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p6">11. Kinfolks - Hebrew. avengers; to whom it belonged to
revenge his death.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p7">13. Vanities - Idols called vanities; because they are
but imaginary deities, and mere nothings; having no power to do either
good or hurt.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p8">15. Gibbethon - Which had been besieged before, but, it
seems, was then relieved, or afterwards recovered by the Philistines;
taking the advantage of the disorders and contentions which were among
their enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p9">19. For his sins - This befell him for his sins. In
walking, &amp;c. - This he might do, either before his reign, in the
whole course of his life, which is justly charged upon him, because of
his impenitency: or during his short reign; in which, he had time enough
to publish his intentions, about the worship of the calves; or to
sacrifice to them, for his good success.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p10">21. Were divided - Fell into a civil war: yet neither
this, nor any other of God's dreadful judgments could win them to
repentance.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p11">22. Prevailed - Partly, because they had the army on
their side; and principally, by the appointment of God, giving up the
Israelites to him who was much the worst, ver. 25, 26. Died - A violent
death, in the battle: but not till after a struggle of some years. But
why in all these confusions of the kingdom of Israel, did they never
think of returning to the house of David? Probably because the kings of
Judah assumed a more absolute power than the kings of Israel. It was the
heaviness of the yoke that they complained of, when they first revolted
from the house of David. And it is not unlikely, the dread of that made
them averse to it ever after.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p12">23. Twelve years - That is, and he reigned twelve years,
not from this thirty-first year of Asa, for he died in his thirty-eighth
year, ver. 29, but from the beginning of his reign, which was in Asa's
twenty-seventh year, ver. 15, 16. So he reigned four years in a state of
war with Tibni, and eight years peaceably.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p13">24. Two talents - Two talents is something more than
seven hundred pounds.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p14">26. Did worse - Perhaps he made severer laws concerning
the calf worship; whence we read of the statutes of Omri, <scripRef passage="Micah vi. 16" id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Mic|6|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Mic.6.16">Micah vi, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p15">31. A light thing - The Hebrew runs, was it a light
thing,&amp;c., that is, was this but a small sin, that therefore he
needed to add more abominations? Where the question, as is usual among
the Hebrew, implies a strong denial; and intimates, that this was no
small sin, but a great crime; and might have satisfied his wicked mind,
without any additions. Jezebel - A woman infamous for her idolatry, and
cruelty, and sorcery, and filthiness. Eth-baal - Called Ithbalus, or
Itobalus in heathen writers. So she was of an heathenish and idolatrous
race. Such as the kings and people of Israel were expressly forbidden to
marry. Baal - The idol which the Sidonians worshipped, which is thought
to be Hercules. And this idolatry was much worse than that of the
calves; because in the calves they worshipped the true God; but in
these, false gods or devils.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p16">34. In his days - This is added,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p17">1. as an instance of the certainty of
divine predictions, this being fulfilled eight hundred years after it
was threatened; and withal, as a warning to the Israelites, not to think
themselves innocent or safe, because the judgment threatened against
them by Ahijah, chap. xiv, 15, was not yet executed. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xvii.ii-p18">2. as an evidence of the horrible
corruption of his times, and of that high contempt of God which then
reigned. The Bethelite - Who lived in Bethel, the seat and sink of
idolatry, wherewith he was throughly leavened. He laid, &amp;c. - That
is, in the beginning of his building, God took away his first-born, and
others successively in the progress of the work, and the youngest when
he finished it. And so he found by his own sad experience, the truth of
God's word.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="64.97%" prev="ii.xii.xvii.ii" next="ii.xii.xviii.i" id="ii.xii.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XVII" id="ii.xii.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="64.97%" prev="ii.xii.xviii" next="ii.xii.xviii.ii" id="ii.xii.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.i-p1">Elijah foretells the drought, ver. 1. Is fed by ravens,
ver. 2-7. By a widow, whose meal and oil are multiplied, ver. 8-16. He
raises her dead son, ver. 17-24</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="64.98%" prev="ii.xii.xviii.i" next="ii.xii.xix" id="ii.xii.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p1">1. Elijah - The most eminent of the prophets, who is here
brought in, like Melchisedek, without any mention of his father, or
mother, or beginning of his days; like a man dropt out of the clouds,
and raised by God's special providence as a witness for himself in this
most degenerate time that by his zeal, and courage and miracles, he
might give some check, to their various and abominable idolatries, and
some reviving to that small number of the Lord's prophets, and people,
who yet remained in Israel. He seems to have been naturally of a rough
spirit. And rough spirits are called to rough services. His name
signifies, my God Jehovah is he: he that sends me, and will own me, and
bear me out. Said to Ahab - Having doubtless admonished him of his sin
and danger before; now upon his obstinacy in his wicked courses, he
proceeds to declare, and execute the judgment of God upon him. As the
Lord, &amp;c. - I Swear by the God of Israel, who is the only true and
living God; whereas the gods whom thou hast joined with him, or
preferred before him, are dead and senseless idols. Before whom - Whose
minister I am, not only in general, but especially in this threatening,
which I now deliver in his name and authority. There shall not, &amp;c.
- This was a prediction, but was seconded with his prayer, that God
would verify it, <scripRef passage="James v. 17" id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Jas|5|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.5.17">James v, 17</scripRef>, And this prayer was truly charitable; that by this sharp
affliction, God's honour, and the truth of his word (which was now so
horribly and universally contemned) might be vindicated; and the
Israelites (whom impunity had hardened in their idolatry) might be
awakened to see their own wickedness, and the necessity of returning to
the true religion. Those years - That is, These following years, which
were three and an half, <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 25" id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Luke|4|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.25">Luke iv, 25</scripRef> <scripRef passage="James v. 17" id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p1.3" parsed="|Jas|5|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.5.17">James v, 17</scripRef>. My word - Until I shall declare, that this judgment shall
cease, and shall pray to God for the removal of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p2">3. Hide thyself - Thus God rescues him from the fury of
Ahab and Jezebel, who, he knew, would seek to destroy him. That Ahab did
not seize on him immediately upon these words must be ascribed to God's
over-ruling providence.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p3">4. Have commanded - Or, I shall command, that is,
effectually move them, by instincts which shall be as forcible with
them, as a law or command is to men. God is said to command both brute
creatures, and senseless things; when he causeth them to do the things
which he intends to effect by them. The ravens - Which he chuseth for
this work; to shew his care and power in providing for the prophet by
those creatures, which are noted for their greediness, that by this
strange experiment he might be taught to trust God in those many and
great difficulties to which he was to be exposed. God could have sent
angels to minister to him. But he chose winged messengers of another
kind to shew he can serve his own purposes as effectually, by the
meanest creatures as by the mightiest. Ravens neglect their own young,
and do not feed them: yet when God pleaseth, they shall feed his
prophet.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p4">6. And flesh - Not raw, but boiled by the ministry of
some angel or man, and left in some place 'till the ravens came for it:
in all which, there is nothing incredible, considering the power and
providence of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p5">7. A while - Hebrew. at the end of days; that is, of a
year; for so the word days is often used. Dried - God so ordering it,
for the punishment of those Israelites who lived near it, and had
hitherto been refreshed by it: and for the exercise of Elijah's faith,
and to teach him to depend upon God alone.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p6">9. Zarephath - A city between Tyre and Sidon, called
Sarepta by St. <scripRef passage="Luke iv. 26" id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Luke|4|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.4.26">Luke iv, 26</scripRef>, and others. Zidon - To the jurisdiction of that city, which
was inhabited by Gentiles. And God's providing for his prophet, first,
by an unclean bird, and then by a Gentile, whom the Jews esteemed
unclean, was a presage of the calling of the Gentiles, and rejection of
the Jews. So Elijah was the first prophet of the Gentiles. Commanded -
Appointed or provided, for that she had as yet no Revelation or command
of God about it, appears from ver. 12.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p7">12. She said - Therefore though she was a Gentile, yet
she owned the God of Israel as the true God. Two sticks - A few sticks,
that number being often used indefinitely for any small number. And die
- For having no more provision, we must needs perish with hunger. For
though the famine was chiefly in the land of Israel, yet the effects of
it were in Tyre and Sidon, which were fed by the corn of that land. But
what a poor supporter was this likely to be? who had no fuel, but what
she gathered in the streets, and nothing to live upon herself, but an
handful of meal and a little oil! To her Elijah is sent, that he might
live upon providence, as much as he had done when the ravens fed
him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p8">13. But make, &amp;c. - This he requires as a trial of
her faith, and obedience, which he knew God would plentifully reward;
and so this would be a great example to encourage others to the practice
of the same graces.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p9">14. The barrel, &amp;c. - The meal of the barrel So the
cruse of oil for the oil of the cruse.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p10">15. Many days - A long time, even above two years, before
the following event about her son happened. And surely the increase of
her faith to such a degree, as to enable her thus to deny herself and
trust the promise, was as great a miracle in the kingdom of grace, as
the increase of her oil in the kingdom of providence. Happy are they who
can thus against hope believe and obey in hope.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p11">16. Wasted not - See how the reward answered the service.
She made one cake for the prophet and was repaid with many for herself
and her son. What is laid out in charity is set out to the best
interest, an upon the best securities.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p12">17. No breath - That is, he died. We must not think it
strange, if we meet with sharp afflictions, even when we are in the way
of eminent service to God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p13">18. She said - Wherein have I injured thee? Or, why didst
thou come to sojourn in my house, if this be the fruit of it? They are
the words of a troubled mind. Art thou come - Didst thou come for this
end, that thou mightest severely observe my sins, and by thy prayers
bring down God's just judgment upon me, as thou hast brought down this
famine upon the nation? To call, &amp;c. - To God's remembrance: for God
is said in scripture, to remember sins, when he punisheth them; and to
forget them, when he spares the sinner.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p14">19. Into a loft - A private place, where he might more
freely pour out his soul to God, and use such gestures as he thought
most proper.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p15">20. He cried - A prayer full of powerful arguments. Thou
art the Lord, that canst revive the child: and my God; and therefore
wilt not, deny me. She is a widow, add not affliction to the afflicted;
deprive her not of the support and staff of her age: she hath given me
kind entertainment: let her not fare the worse for her kindness to a
prophet, whereby wicked men will take occasion to reproach both her, and
religion.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p16">21. Come into him - By which it is evident, that the soul
was gone out of his body, this was a great request; but Elijah was
encouraged to make it; by his zeal for God's honour, and by the
experience which he had of his prevailing power with God in prayer.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xviii.ii-p17">22. Into him again - This plainly supposes the existence
of the soul in a state of separation, and consequently its immortality:
probably God might design by this miracle to give an evidence hereof,
for the encouragement of his suffering people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="65.11%" prev="ii.xii.xviii.ii" next="ii.xii.xix.i" id="ii.xii.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XVIII" id="ii.xii.xix-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="65.11%" prev="ii.xii.xix" next="ii.xii.xix.ii" id="ii.xii.xix.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xix.i-p1">Elijah sends notice to Ahab of his coming, ver. 1-16. His
interview with Ahab, ver. 17-19. His interview with all Israel upon
mount Carmel, ver. 21-39. He slays the prophets of Baal, ver. 40.
Obtains rain, and runs before Ahab to Jezreel, ver. 41-46.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="65.11%" prev="ii.xii.xix.i" next="ii.xii.xx" id="ii.xii.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p1">1. The third year - Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p2">1. From the time when he went to hide
himself by the brook Cherith; six months before which time the famine
might begin. And so this being towards the end of the third year, it
makes up these three years and six months, <scripRef passage="James v. 17" id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Jas|5|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jas.5.17">James v, 17</scripRef>. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p3">2. From the time of his going to Sarepta,
which probably was a year after the famine begun; So this might be in
the middle of the third year, which also makes up the three years and
six months. Go to Ahab - To acquaint him with the cause of this
judgment, and to advise him to remove it, and upon that condition to
promise him rain. Will send - According to thy word and prayer, which
thou shalt make for it. Thus God takes care to maintain the honour of
his prophet, and in judgment remembers mercy to Israel, for the sake of
the holy seed yet left among them, who suffered in this common
calamity.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p4">2. Elijah went - Wherein he shews a strong faith, and
resolute obedience, and invincible courage, that he durst at God's
command run into the mouth of this raging lion.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p5">3. Obadiah - Being valued by Ahab for his great prudence
and fidelity, and therefore indulged as to the worship of the calves and
Baal. "But how could he and some other Israelites be said to fear the
Lord, when they did not go up to Jerusalem to worship, as God had
commanded?" Although they seem not to be wholly excusable in this
neglect, yet because they worshipped God in spirit and truth, and
performed all moral duties to God and their brethren, and abstained from
idolatry, being kept from Jerusalem by violence, God bares with their
infirmity herein.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p6">4. Prophets - This name is not only given to such as are
endowed with an extraordinary spirit of prophecy, but to such ministers
as devoted themselves to the service of God in preaching, praying, and
praising God. And fed - With the hazard of his own life, and against the
king's command; as wisely considering, that no command of an earthly
prince could over-rule the command of the king of kings. Bread and water
- With meat and drink. See how wonderfully God raises up friends for his
ministers and people where one would least expect them!</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p7">7. And fell - By this profound reverence, shewing his
great respect and love to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p8">8. Thy Lord - Ahab: whom, though a very wicked man, he
owns for Obadiah's Lord and king; thereby instructing us, that the
wickedness of kings doth not exempt their subjects from obedience to
their lawful commands.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p9">9. He said - Wherein have I offended God, and thee, that
thou shouldest expose me to certain ruin.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p10">10. No nation - Near his own, where he could in reason
think that Elijah had hid himself. It does not appear, that Ahab sought
him, in order to put him to death: but rather in hopes of prevailing
upon him, to pray for the removal of the drought.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p11">12. Carry thee - Such transportations of the prophets
having doubtless been usual before this time, as they were after it.
Slay me - Either as one that hath deluded him with vain hopes: or,
because I did not seize upon thee, and bring thee to him. But I, &amp;c.
- He speaks not these words, in a way of boasting; but that he might
move the prophet to spare him, and not put him upon that hazardous
action.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p12">17. Ahab said - Have I at last met with thee, O thou
disturber of my kingdom, the author of this famine, and all our
calamities?</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p13">18. He answered - These calamities are not to be imputed
to me, but thine and thy father's wickedness. He answered him boldly,
because he spoke in God's name, and for his honour and service. Ye - All
of you have forsaken the Lord, and thou in particular, hast followed
Baalim.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p14">19. Send - Messengers, that this controversy may be
decided, what is the cause of these heavy judgments. All Israel - By
their heads, or representatives, that they may be witnesses of all our
transactions. Carmel - Not that Carmel, in Judah, but another in
Issachar by the midland sea, which he chose as a convenient place being
not far from the center of his kingdom, to which all the tribes might
conveniently resort, and at some distance from Samaria, that Jezebel
might not hinder. Prophets of Baal - Who were dispersed in all the parts
of the kingdom. Of the groves - Who attended upon those Baal's or idols
that were worshipped in the groves, which were near the royal city, and
much frequented by the king and the queen.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p15">20. Ahab sent - He complied with Elijah's motion; because
the urgency of the present distress made him willing to try all means to
remove it; from a curiosity of seeing some extraordinary events; and
principally, because God inclined his heart.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p16">21. And said - Why do you walk so lamely and unevenly,
being so unsteady in your opinions and practices, and doubting whether
it is better to worship God or Baal? If the Lord - Whom you pretend to
worship. Follow - Worship him, and him only, and that in such place and
manner as he hath commanded you. If Baal - If Baal can prove himself to
be the true God. Answered not - Being convinced of the reasonableness of
his proposition.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p17">22. I only - Here present, to own the cause of God. As
far the other prophets of the Lord, many of them were slain, others
banished, or hid in caves.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p18">23. Let then, &amp;c. - To put this controversy to a
short issue.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p19">24. By Fire - That shall consume the sacrifice by fire
sent from heaven; which the people knew the true God used to do. It was
a great condescension in God, that he would permit Baal to be a
competitor with him. But thus God would have every mouth to be stopped,
and all flesh become silent before him. And Elijah doubtless had a
special commission from God, or he durst not have put it to this issue.
But the case was extraordinary, and the judgment upon it would be of use
not only then, but in all ages. Elijah does not say, The God that
answers by water, tho' that was the thing the country needed, but that
answers by fire, let him be God; because the atonement was to be made,
before the judgment could be removed. The God therefore that has power
to pardon sin, and to signify that by consuming the sin-offering, must
needs be the God that can relieve us against the calamity.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p20">25. Dress it first - And I am willing to give you the
precedency. This he did, because if he had first offered, and God had
answered by fire, Baal's priests would have desisted from making the
trial on their part; and because the disappointment of the priests of
Baal, of which he was well assured, would prepare the way for the
people's attention to his words, and cause them to entertain his success
with more affection; and this coming last would leave the greater
impression upon their hearts. And this they accepted, because they might
think, that if Baal answered them first, which they presumed he would,
the people would be so confirmed and heightened in their opinion of
Baal, that they might murder Elijah before he came to his
experiment.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p21">26. Dressed - Cut it in pieces, and laid the parts upon
the wood. From morning - From the time of the morning sacrifice; which
advantage Elijah suffered them to take. They leapt upon - Or, beside the
altar: or, before it. They used some superstitious and disorderly
gestures, either pretending to be acted by the spirit of their God, and
to be in a kind of religious extasy; or, in way of devotion to their
God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p22">27. Mocked them - Derided them and their gods, which had
now proved themselves to be ridiculous and contemptible things.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p23">28. Cut themselves - Mingling their own blood with their
sacrifices; as knowing by experience, that nothing was more acceptable
to their Baal (who was indeed the devil) than human blood; and hoping
thereby to move their God to help them. And this indeed was the practice
of divers Heathens in the worship of their false gods.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p24">29. Prophesied - That is, prayed to, and worshipped their
God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p25">30. The altar - This had been built by some of their
ancestors for the offering of sacrifice to the God of Israel, which was
frequently done in high places. Broken down - By some of the Baalites,
out of their enmity to the true God, whose temple, because they could
not reach, they shewed their malignity in destroying his altars.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p26">31. Twelve stones - This he did, to renew the covenant
between God and all the tribes, as Moses did, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxiv. 4" id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p26.1" parsed="|Exod|24|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.24.4">Exod. xxiv, 4</scripRef>, to shew, that he prayed and acted in the name, and for the
service of the God of all the Patriarchs, and of all the tribes of
Israel, and for their good: and, to teach the people, that though the
tribes were divided as to their civil government, they ought all to be
united in the worship of the same God. Israel - Jacob was graciously
answered by God when he prayed to him, and was honoured with the
glorious title of Israel, which noted his prevalency with God and men.
And I, calling upon the same God, doubt not of a like gracious answer;
and if ever you mean to have your prayers granted, you must seek to the
God of Jacob.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p27">33. With water - This they could quickly fetch, either
from the river Kishon; or, if that was dried up, from the sea; both were
at the foot of the mountain. This he did to make the miracle more
glorious, and more unquestionable.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p28">36. The evening sacrifice - This time he chose, that he
might unite his prayers with the prayers of the godly Jews at Jerusalem,
who at that time assembled together to pray. Lord God of, &amp;c. -
Hereby he shews faith in God's ancient covenant, and also reminds the
people, of their relation both to God and to the patriarchs. Done these
things - Brought this famine, gathered the people hither, and done what
I have done, or am doing here; not in compliance with my own passions,
but in obedience to thy command.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p29">37. Hast turned - Let them feel so powerful a change in
their hearts, that they may know it is thy work. Back again - Unto thee,
from whom they have revolted.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p30">38. Consumed - Solomon's altar was consecrated by fire
from heaven; but this was destroyed, because no more to be used.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p31">39. They fell - In acknowledgment of the true God. He is
God - He alone; and Baal is a senseless idol. And they double the words,
to note their abundant satisfaction and assurance of the truth of their
assertion.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p32">40. Elijah said - He takes the opportunity, whilst the
peoples hearts were warm with the fresh sense of this great miracle. The
brook Kishon - That their blood might be poured into that river, and
thence conveyed into the sea, and might not defile the holy land. Slew
them - As these idolatrous priests were manifestly under a sentence of
death, passed upon such by the sovereign Lord of life and death, so
Elijah had authority to execute it, being a prophet, and an
extraordinary minister of God's vengeance. The four hundred prophets of
the groves, it seems, did not attend, and so escaped, which perhaps Ahab
rejoiced in. But it proved, they were reserved to be the instruments of
his destruction, by encouraging him to go up to Ramoth-Gilead.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p33">41. Get up - From the river, where he had been present at
the slaughter of Baal's priests, to thy tent: which probably was pitched
on the side of Carmel. Eat, &amp;c. - Take comfort, and refresh thyself:
for neither the king, nor any of the people could have leisure to eat,
being wholly intent upon the decision of the great controversy. For
there is, &amp;c. - The rain is as certainly coming, as if you heard the
noise which it makes.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p34">42. The top of Carmel - Where he might pour out his
prayers unto God; and whence he might look towards the sea. He had a
large prospect of the sea from hence. The sailors at this day call it
cape Carmel. Between his knees - That is, bowed his head so low, that it
touched his knees; thus abasing himself in the sense of his own
meanness, now God had thus honoured him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p35">43. Go - While I continue praying. Elijah desired to have
timely notice of the first appearance of rain, that Ahab and the people
might know that it was obtained from Jehovah by the prophet's prayers,
and thereby be confirmed in the true religion.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p36">44. Like a man's hand - Great blessings often rise from
small beginnings, and showers of plenty from a cloud of a span long. Let
us therefore never despise the day of small things, but hope and wait
for greater things from it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xix.ii-p37">46. The hand, &amp;c. - God gave him more than natural
strength, whereby he was enabled to outrun Ahab's chariot, for so many
miles together. He girded, &amp;c. - That his garments, which were long,
might not hinder him. Ran before Ahab - To shew how ready he was to
honour and serve the king, that by this humble and self-denying
carriage, it might appear, what he had done was not from envy or
passion, but only from a just zeal for God's glory: that by his presence
with the king and his courtiers, he might animate and oblige them to
proceed in the reformation of religion: and, to demonstrate, that he was
neither ashamed of, nor afraid for what he had done, but durst venture
himself in the midst of his enemies.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="65.34%" prev="ii.xii.xix.ii" next="ii.xii.xx.i" id="ii.xii.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XIX" id="ii.xii.xx-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="65.34%" prev="ii.xii.xx" next="ii.xii.xx.ii" id="ii.xii.xx.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xx.i-p1">Elijah flees from Jezebel, ver. 1-3. Is fed by an angel,
ver. 4- 8. God manifests himself and directs him, ver. 9-18. He calls
Elisha, ver. 19-21.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="65.34%" prev="ii.xii.xx.i" next="ii.xii.xxi" id="ii.xii.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p1">1. All the prophets - Of Baal.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p2">2. Jezebel sent - She gives him notice of it before hand:
partly, out of the height of her spirit, as scorning to kill him
secretly: partly, out of her impatience, till she had breathed out her
rage: and principally, from God's all-disposing providence, that so he
might have an opportunity of escaping. Do to me, &amp;c. - So far was
she from being changed by that evident miracle, that she persists in her
former idolatry, and adds to it a monstrous confidence, that in spight
of God she would destroy his prophet.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p3">3. Left his servant - Because he would not expose him to
those perils and hardships which he expected: and because he desired
solitude, that he might more freely converse with God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p4">4. Into the wilderness - The vast wilderness of Arabia.
He durst not stay in Judah, tho' good Jehosaphat reigned there, because
he was allied to Ahab, and was a man of an easy temper, whom Ahab might
circumvent, and either by force or art seize upon Elijah. It is enough -
I have lived long enough for thy service, and am not like to do thee any
more service; neither my words nor works are like to do any good upon
these unstable and incorrigible people. I am not better - That I should
continue in life, when other prophets who have gone before me, have lost
their lives.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p5">7. Angel of the Lord, &amp;c. - He needed not to complain
of the unkindness of men, when it was thus made up by the ministration
of angels. Wherever God's children are, they are still under their
father's eye.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p6">8. And went - He wandered hither and thither for forty
days, 'till at last he came to Horeb, which in the direct road was not
above three or four days journey. Thither the spirit of the Lord led
him, probably beyond his own intention, that he might have communion
with God, in the same place that Moses had.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p7">9. Unto a cave - Perhaps the same wherein Moses was hid
when the Lord passed before him, and proclaimed his name.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p8">10. I have been, &amp;c. - I have executed my office with
zeal for God's honour, and with the hazard of my own life, and am fled
hither, not being able to endure to see the dishonour done to thy name
by their obstinate idolatry and wickedness. I only - Of all thy
prophets, who boldly and publickly plead thy cause: for the rest of thy
prophets who are not slain, hide themselves, and dare not appear to do
thee any service. They seek my life - I despair of doing them any good:
for instead of receiving my testimony, they hunt for my life. It does by
no means appear, that he was at all to blame, for fleeing from Jezebel.
If they persecute you in one city flee into another. Besides, the angels
feeding and preparing him for his journey, and the peculiar blessing of
God upon that food, indicated the divine approbation.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p9">11. And behold - This is a general description of the
thing, after which the manner of it is particularly explained. Strong
wind - Whereby he both prepares Elijah to receive this discovery of God
with greatest humility, reverence, and godly fear; and signifies his
irresistible power, to break the hardest hearts of the Israelites, and
to bear down all opposition that was or should be made against him in
the discharge of his office. The Lord was not - The Lord did not
vouchsafe his special and gracious presence to Elijah in that wind,
which possibly was to teach him not to wonder if God did not accompany
his terrible administration at mount Carmel with the presence of his
grace, to turn the hearts of the Israelites to himself.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p10">12. A still voice - To intimate, that God would do his
work in and for Israel in his own time, not by might or power, but by
his own spirit, <scripRef passage="Zech iv. 6" id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Zech|4|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.4.6">Zech iv, 6</scripRef>, which moves with a powerful, but yet with a sweet and
gentle gale.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p11">13. He wrapped, &amp;c. - Through dread of God's
presence, being sensibly that he was neither worthy nor able to endure
the sight of God with open face. And stood, &amp;c. - Which God
commanded him to do; and as he was going towards the mouth of the cave,
he was affrighted and stopped in his course, by the dreadful wind, and
earthquake, and fire; when these were past, he prosecutes his journey,
and goeth on to the mouth of the cave.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p12">16. The son, &amp;c. - That is, his grand-son, for he was
the son of Jehosaphat, <scripRef passage="2 Kings ix. 2" id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p12.1" parsed="|2Kgs|9|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.9.2">2 Kings ix, 2</scripRef>. This was intended as a prediction that by these God would
punish the degenerate Israelites, plead his own cause among them, and
avenge the quarrel of his covenant.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p13">17. Shall Elisha slay - One or other of these should
infallibly execute God's judgments upon the apostate Israelites. Elisha
is said to slay them, either, because he slew those forty two children, <scripRef passage="2 Kings ii. 24" id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p13.1" parsed="|2Kgs|2|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.2.24">2 Kings ii, 24</scripRef>, besides others whom upon like occasions he might destroy;
or, because he by God's appointment inflicted the famine, <scripRef passage="2 Kings viii. 1" id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p13.2" parsed="|2Kgs|8|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.8.1">2 Kings viii, 1</scripRef>, or rather, by the sword which came out of his mouth: the
prophets being said to pull down and to destroy what they declare and
foretel shall be pulled down. Hazael began to slay them before Jehu was
king, though his cruelty was much increased afterward. Jehu destroyed
those whom Hazael did not, as king Joram himself, and Ahaziah, and all
the near relations of Ahab.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p14">18. I have left - Or, I have reserved to myself; I have
kept from the common contagion: therefore thou art mistaken to think
that thou art left alone. Seven thousand - Either, definitely so many:
or rather, indefinitely, for many thousands; the number of seven being
often used for a great number. Kissed him - That is, all those who have
not worshipped Baal, nor professed reverence or subjection to him: which
idolaters did to their idols, by bowing the knee, and by kissing
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p15">19. Was plowing - Who had twelve ploughs going, whereof
eleven were managed by his servants, and the last by himself; according
to the simplicity of those ancient times, in which men of good estate
submitted to the meanest employments. Cast his mantle - By that ceremony
conferring upon him the office of a prophet, which God was pleased to
accompany with the gifts and graces of his spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p16">20. He ran - Being powerfully moved by God's spirit to
follow Elijah, and wholly give up himself to his function. Let me kiss -
That is, bid them farewell. Go - And take thy leave of them, and then
return to me again. For what, &amp;c. - Either first, to hinder thee
from performing that office. That employment to which I have called
thee, doth not require an alienation of thy heart from thy parents, nor
the total neglect of them. Or, secondly, to make such a change in thee,
that thou shouldst be willing to forsake thy parents, and lands, and
all, that thou mayest follow me. Whence comes this marvelous change? It
is not from me, who did only throw my mantle over thee; but from an
higher power, even from God's spirit, which both changed thy heart, and
consecrated thee to thy prophetical office: which therefore it concerns
thee vigourously to execute, and wholly to devote thyself to it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xx.ii-p17">21. From him - From Elijah to his parents; whom when he
had seen and kissed, he returned to Elijah. The instruments - That is,
with the wood belonging to the plow, &amp;c. to which more was added, as
occasion required. But that he burned, to shew his total relinquishing
of his former employment. And gave - That is, he made thereof a feast
for his servants who had been ploughing with him, and for him, and his
other friends and neighbours who came to take their leave of him. Hereby
he shewed how willingly and joyfully he forsook all his friends, that he
might serve God in that high and honourable employment. It is of great
advantage to young ministers, to spend some time under the direction of
those that are aged and experienced; and not to think much, if occasion
be, to minister unto them. Those who would be fit to teach, must have
time to learn; those should first serve, who may hereafter rule.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="65.48%" prev="ii.xii.xx.ii" next="ii.xii.xxi.i" id="ii.xii.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XX" id="ii.xii.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="65.48%" prev="ii.xii.xxi" next="ii.xii.xxi.ii" id="ii.xii.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.i-p1">Ben-hadad's invasion of Israel and insolent demand, ver.
1- 12. Ahab, encouraged by a prophet, overthrows him twice, ver. 13-30.
Makes a covenant with him, ver. 31-34. Is reproved and threatened by a
prophet, ver. 35-43.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="65.48%" prev="ii.xii.xxi.i" next="ii.xii.xxii" id="ii.xii.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p1">1. Gathered his host - To war against Israel: wherein his
design was to enlarge the conquest which his father had made, but God's
design was to punish Israel for their apostacy and idolatry.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p2">3. Thy silver, &amp;c. - I challenge them as my own, and
expect to have them forthwith delivered, if thou expect peace with
me.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p3">4. The king said - I do so far comply with thy demand,
that I will own thee for my Lord, and myself for thy vassal, and will
hold my wives, and children, and estate, as by thy favour, and with an
acknowledgment.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p4">5. Saying, &amp;c. - Although I did before demand not
only the dominion of thy treasures, and wives, and children, as thou
mayst seem to understand me, but also the actual portion of them;
wherewith I would then have been contented.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p5">6. Yet, &amp;c. - Yet now I will not accept of those
terms, but together with thy royal treasures, I expect all the treasures
of thy servants or subjects; nor will I wait 'till thou deliver them to
me, but I will send my servants into the city, and they shall search out
and take away all thou art fond of, and this to prevent fraud and delay;
and then I will grant thee a peace.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p6">7. Seeketh mischief - Though he pretended peace, upon
these terms propounded, it is apparent by those additional demands, that
he intends nothing less than our utter ruin. I denied not - I granted
his demands in the sense before mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p7">10. And said, &amp;c. - If I do not assault thy city with
so numerous an army, as shall turn all thy city into an heap of dust,
and shall be sufficient to carry it all away, though every soldier take
but one handful of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p8">11. Let not him, &amp;c. - Do not triumph before the
victory, for the events of war are uncertain.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p9">13. And behold, &amp;c. - God, though forsaken and
neglected by Ahab, prevents him with his gracious promise of help: that
Ahab and the idolatrous Israelites, might hereby be fully convinced, or
left without excuse, that Ben-hadad's intolerable pride, and contempt of
God, and of his people, might be punished: and that the remnant of his
prophets and people who were involved in the same calamity with the rest
of the Israelites, might be preserved and delivered. I am the Lord - And
not Baal, because I will deliver thee, which he cannot do.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p10">14. He said, &amp;c. - Not by old and experienced
soldiers, but by those young men; either the sons of the princes, and
great men of the land, who were fled thither for safety; or their pages,
or servants that used to attend them: who are bred up delicately, and
seem unfit for the business. Thou - Partly to encourage the young men to
fight courageously, as being the presence of their prince: and partly,
that it might appear, that the victory was wholly due to God's gracious
providence, and not to the valour or worthiness of the instruments.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p11">15. All Israel - All that were fit to go out to war; all,
except those whom their age, or the same infirmity excused.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p12">18. Take them - He bids them not fight, for he thought
they needed not to strike one stroke; and that the Israelites could not
stand the first brunt.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p13">20. His man - Him who came to seize upon him, as
Ben-hadad had commanded. Fled - Being amazed at the unexpected and
undaunted courage of the Israelites, and struck with a divine
terror.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p14">21. The king went - Proceeded further in his march. Smote
the chariots - The men that fought from them.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p15">22. Mark, and see - Consider what is necessary for thee
to do by way of preparation. The enemies of the children of God, are
restless in their malice and tho' they may take some breathing time for
themselves, they are still breathing out slaughter against the church.
It therefore concerns us always to expect our spiritual enemies, and to
mark and see what we do.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p16">23. Said to him - They suppose that their gods were no
better than the Syrian gods and that there were many gods who had each
his particular charge and jurisdiction; which was the opinion of all
heathen nations; that some were gods of the woods, other of the rivers,
and others of the mountains; and they fancied these to be the latter,
because the land of Canaan was a mountainous land, and the great temple
of their God at Jerusalem, stood upon an hill, and so did Samaria, where
they had received their last blow: it is observable, they do not impute
their ill success to their negligence, and drunkenness, and bad conduct,
nor to the valour of the Israelites; but to a divine power, which was
indeed visible in it. In the plain - Wherein there was not only
superstition, but policy; because the Syrians excelled the Israelites in
horses, which are most serviceable in plain ground.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p17">24. Take the kings away - Who being of softer education,
and less experienced in military matters, were less fit for service; and
being many of them but mercenaries, and therefore less concerned in his
good success, would be more cautions in venturing themselves. Captains -
That is, experienced soldiers of his own subjects, who would faithfully
obey the commands of the general (to which the kings would not so
readily yield) and use their utmost skill and valour for their own
interest and advancement.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p18">27. And went - Being encouraged by the remembrance of
their former success, and an expectation of assistance from God again.
And pitched - Probably upon some hilly ground, where they might secure
themselves, and watch for advantage against their enemies; which may be
the reason why the Syrians durst not assault them before the seventh
day, ver. 29. Little flocks - Few, and weak, being also for conveniency
of fighting, and that they might seem to be more than they were, divided
into two bodies.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p19">30. The wall - Or, the walls (the singular number, for
the plural) of the city; in which they were now fortifying themselves.
This might possibly happen thro' natural causes; but most probably, was
effected by the mighty power of God, sending some earthquake, or violent
storm which threw down the walls upon them; or doing this by the
ministry of angels. And if ever miracle was to be wrought, now seems to
have been the proper season for it; when the blasphemous Syrians denied
the sovereign power of God, and thereby in some sort obliged him, to
give a proof of it; and to shew, that he was the God of the plains, as
well as of the mountains; and that he could as effectually destroy them
in their strongest holds, as in the open fields; and make the very
walls, to whose strength they trusted for their defense, to be the
instruments of their ruin. But it may be farther observed, that it is
not said, that all these were killed by the fall of this wall; but only
that the wall fell upon them, killing some, and wounding others.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p20">31. He will save thy life - This encouragement have all
poor sinners, to repent and humble themselves before God. The God of
Israel is a merciful God; let us rend our hearts and return to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p21">32. My brother - I do not only pardon him, but honour and
love him as my brother. What a change is here! From the height of
prosperity, to the depth of distress. See the uncertainty of human
affairs! Such turns are they subject to, that the spoke of the wheel
which is uppermost now, may soon be the lowest of all.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p22">33. Thy brother - Understand, Liveth: for that he
inquired after, ver. 32.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p23">34. Streets - Or, Markets, &amp;c. places where thou
mayest either receive the tribute which I promise to pay thee, or
exercise judicature upon my subjects in case of their refusal. So he
made, &amp;c. - He takes no notice of his blasphemy against God; nor of
the injuries which his people had suffered from him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p24">35. In the word - ln the name, and by the command of God,
whereof doubtless he had informed him. Smite me - So as to wound me,
ver. 37. He speaks what God commanded him, though it was to his own
hurt; by which obedience to God, he secretly reproacheth Ahab's
disobedience in a far easier matter. And this the prophet by God's
appointment desires, that looking like a wounded soldier, he might have
the more free access to the king. Refused - Not out of contempt of God's
command, but probably, in tenderness to his brother.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p25">36. Slew him - We cannot judge of the case; this man
might be guilty of many other heinous sins unknown to us but known to
God; for which, God might justly cut him off: which God chose to do upon
this occasion, that by the severity of this punishment of a prophet's
disobedience, proceeding from pity to his brother, he might teach Ahab
the greatness of his sin, in sparing him through foolish pity, whom by
the laws of religion, and justice, and prudence, he should have cut
of.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p26">38. With ashes - Or, with a cloath, or band; (as the
Hebrew doctors understand the word) whereby he bound up his wound, which
probably was in his face; for it was to be made in a conspicuous place,
that it might be visible to Ahab and others.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p27">39. He said - This relation is a parable; an usual way of
instruction in the eastern parts, and most fit for this occasion wherein
an obscure prophet was to speak to a great king; impatient of a
down-right reproof, and exceeding partial in his own cause. A man - My
commander as the manner of expression sheweth.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p28">40. Thy judgment - Thy sentence; thou must perform the
condition. Either suffer the one, or do the other.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p29">42. Thy life - "What was the great sin of Ahab in this
action, for which God so severely punisheth him?" The great dishonour
hereby done to God, in suffering so horrid a blasphemer, to go
unpunished, which was contrary to an express law, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxiv. 16" id="ii.xii.xxi.ii-p29.1" parsed="|Lev|24|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.24.16">Lev. xxiv, 16</scripRef>. And God had delivered him into Ahab's hand, for his
blasphemy, as he promised to do, ver. 28, by which act of his
providence, compared with that law, it was most evident, that this man
was appointed by God to destruction, but Ahab was so far from punishing
this blasphemer, that he doth not so much as rebuke him, but dismisseth
him upon easy terms, and takes not the least care for the reparation of
God's honour, and the people were punished for their own sins, which
were many, and great; though God took this occasion to inflict it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="65.66%" prev="ii.xii.xxi.ii" next="ii.xii.xxii.i" id="ii.xii.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XXI" id="ii.xii.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="65.66%" prev="ii.xii.xxii" next="ii.xii.xxii.ii" id="ii.xii.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.i-p1">Ahab covets Naboth's vineyard, ver. 1-4. Jezebel procures
Naboth to be stoned, ver. 5-14. Ahab goes to take possession, ver. 15,
16 Elijah meets him, and denounces the judgment of God, ver. 17-24. Upon
his humiliation a reprieve is granted, ver. 25-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="65.66%" prev="ii.xii.xxii.i" next="ii.xii.xxiii" id="ii.xii.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p1">3. The Lord forbid - For God had expressly, and for
divers weighty reasons forbidden the alienation of lands from the tribes
and families to which they were allotted. And although these might have
been alienated 'till the jubilee, yet he durst not sell it to the king
for that time; because he supposed, if once it came into the king's
hand, neither he, nor his posterity, could ever recover it; and so he
should both offend God, and wrong his posterity.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p2">7. Dost thou govern - Art thou fit to be king, that hast
not courage to use thy power.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p3">9. A fast - To remove all suspicion of evil design in
Ahab, and to beget a good opinion of him amongst his people, as if he
were grown zealous for God's honour, and careful of his people's
welfare, and therefore desirous to inquire into all those sins which
provoked God against them. On high - On a scaffold, or high- place,
where malefactors were usually placed, that they might be seen, and
heard by all the people.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p4">10. Blaspheme God and the king - Indeed his blaspheming
God would only be the forfeiture of his life, not his estate. Therefore
he is charged with treason also, that his estate may be confiscated, and
so Ahab have his vineyard.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p5">13. Stoned him - And it seems his sons too, either with
him or after him. For God afterward says, (<scripRef passage="2 Kings ix. 26" id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|2Kgs|9|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.9.26">2 Kings ix, 26</scripRef>) I have seen the blood of Naboth and the blood of his sons.
Let us commit the keeping of our lives and comforts to God; for
innocence itself will not always be our security.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p6">19. Saying - Thou hast murdered an innocent man; and
instead of repenting for it, hast added another piece of injustice and
violence to it, and art going confidently and cheerfully to reap the
fruit of thy wickedness. Thy blood - The threatening was so directed at
first; but afterwards, upon his humiliation, the punishment was
transferred from him to his son, as is expressed, ver. 29, yet upon
Ahab's returning to sin, in the next chapter, he brings back the curse
upon himself, and so it is no wonder if it be in some sort fulfilled in
him also.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p7">20. Hast thou found - Dost thou pursue me from place to
place? Wilt thou never let me rest? Art thou come after me hither with
thy unwelcome messages? Thou art always disturbing, threatening, and
opposing me. I have - The hand of God hath found and overtaken thee.
Sold thyself - Thou hast wholly resigned up thyself to be the bondslave
of the devil, as a man that sells himself to another is totally in his
master's power. To work evil, &amp;c. - Impudently and contemptuously.
Those who give themselves up to sin will certainly be found out, sooner
or later, to their unspeakable amazement.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p8">23. By the wall - Or, in the portion, as it is explained <scripRef passage="2 Kings ix. 36" id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|2Kgs|9|36|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.9.36">2 Kings ix,
36</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p9">24. Him that dieth, &amp;c. - Punishments after death are
here most insisted on. And these, tho' lighting on the body only, yet
undoubtedly were designed as figures of the soul's misery in an after
state.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p10">25 Was none - None among all the kings of Israel which
had been before him. Whom Jezebel - This is added to shew, that
temptations to sin are no excuse to the sinner.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p11">27. Softly - Slowly and silently, after the manner of
mourners, or those who are under a great consternation.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxii.ii-p12">29. Humbleth himself - His humiliation was real, though
not lasting, and accordingly pleasing to God. This discovers the great
goodness of God, and his readiness to shew mercy. It teaches us to take
notice of that which is good, even in the worst of men. It gives a
reason why wicked persons often prosper: God rewards what little good is
in them. And it encourages true penitents. If even Ahab goes to his
house reprieved, doubtless they shall go to their houses justified.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="65.73%" prev="ii.xii.xxii.ii" next="ii.xii.xxiii.i" id="ii.xii.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Kings XXII" id="ii.xii.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|1Kgs|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xii.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="65.73%" prev="ii.xii.xxiii" next="ii.xii.xxiii.ii" id="ii.xii.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.i-p1">Ahab invites Jehoshaphat to join in recovering Ramoth-
gilead, ver. 1-4. His false prophets promise him success, ver. 5, 6. He
sends for Micaiah, ver. 7-10. Farther promises, ver. 11, 12. Micaiah's
uprightness and prediction, ver. 13-23. He is abused and imprisoned,
ver. 24-28. An account of the battle, wherein Ahab is slain, ver. 29-40.
The good reign of Jehoshaphat, ver. 41-50. The wicked reign of Ahaziah,
ver. 51-53.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXII" progress="65.74%" prev="ii.xii.xxiii.i" next="ii.xiii" id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p1">2. Came down, &amp;c. - It is strange, that so good a man
would be so closely connected with a king revolted from the worship of
God! But he appears to have been of too easy a temper, which betrayed
him to many inconveniencies.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p2">3. Is ours - Belongeth to us by right. both by God's
donation, and by our last agreement with Ben-hadad, chap. xx, 34, which
yet he refuseth to deliver up.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p3">5. Inquire - A good man, wherever he goes, will take God
along with him, will acknowledge him in all his ways, and look to him
for success. And wherever he goes, he ought to take his religion along
with him: and not be ashamed to own it, even among those who have no
kindness for it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p4">6. The prophets - Doubtless his own false prophets, or
the priests of the groves; who yet gave in their answer in the name of
Jehovah; either, in compliance with Jehoshaphat, or by Ahab's direction,
that Jehoshaphat might be deceived by them, into a good opinion of the
war.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p5">8. One man - In this place, for whom I can speedily send:
for there were also other prophets elsewhere in the kingdom, but these
were not at hand. Micaiah - Not one of the twelve prophets, who lived
about a hundred and fifty years after this time, but another of that
name. Let not, &amp;c. - Let us neither hate his person, nor despise his
message; but first hear it, and then do as we see cause.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p6">9. Micaiah - It seems, he had imprisoned him; for ver.
26, he bids the officer carry him back, namely to the place where he was
before. Probably this was he that had reproved him, for letting
Ben-hadad go: And for that, had lain in prison three years. But this did
not make him less confident, or less faithful in delivering his
message.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p7">14. Said - What answer God shall put in to my mouth.
Bravely resolved! And as became one who had an eye to a greater king
than either of these.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p8">15. Go - Using the very words of the false prophets, in
way of derision. Micaiah's meaning is plainly this, because thou dost
not seek to know the truth, but only to please thyself, go to the
battle, as all thy prophets advise thee, and try the truth of their
prediction by thy own experience.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p9">17. I saw - In the spirit, or in a vision. The hills -
Upon the mountains of Gilead, nigh Ramoth, where they lay encamped by
Ahab's order. As sheep - As people who have lost their king. Return -
Discharged from the war: which was fulfilled, ver. 26.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p10">18. Evil - Nay, but what evil was it, to tell him, what
would be the event, if he proceeded in his expedition, while it was in
his own power, whether he would proceed, or no? The greatest kindness we
can do to one that is walking in a dangerous way, is to tell him of his
danger.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p11">19. He said - I will give thee a distinct and true
account of the whole matter, in God's name and presence. I saw - By the
eyes of my mind: for he could not see the Lord with bodily eyes. The
Host - The angels, both good and bad, the one possibly on his right, the
other on his left hand. Nor is it strange that the devils are called the
host of heaven; if you consider, first, that their original seat was in
heaven. Secondly, that the name of heaven is often given to all that
part of the world which is above the earth, and among the rest, to the
air, and where the devil's residence and dominion lies, <scripRef passage="Eph. ii. 2" id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Eph|2|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Eph.2.2">Eph. ii, 2</scripRef>, and that both Michael and his angels, and the Dragon and
his angels, are said to be, and to wage war in heaven, <scripRef passage="Rev. xii. 7" id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p11.2" parsed="|Rev|12|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Rev.12.7">Rev. xii, 7</scripRef>, either the air, or the church.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p12">20. Who shall - This is not to be grossly understood, as
if God were at a loss to find out an expedient to accomplish his own
will; but only to bring down divine things to our shallow capacities,
and to express the various means which God hath to execute his own
designs.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p13">21. A spirit - An evil spirit came, and presented himself
before the throne.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p14">22. He said - I will inspire a lie into the minds and
mouths of his prophets. Thou shalt - I will give them up into thy hands,
and leave them to their own ignorance and wickedness. Go - This is not a
command, but only a permission.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p15">24. Zedekiah - The chief of the false prophets, who was
much in the king's favour. Which way - In what manner went it? Forasmuch
as I and my brethren have consulted the Lord, and have the same spirit
which thou pretendest to have.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p16">25. Hide thyself - Probably he went with Ahab to the
battle, after which he was glad to shelter himself where he could.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p17">27. Bread, &amp;c. - With a very course and sparing diet,
whereby he may be only supported to endure his torment.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p18">31. Save only - This he ordered, truly supposing this to
be the best way to put an end to the war: and by the providence of God,
which disposeth the hearts of kings as he pleaseth; and inclined them to
this course, that they might, though ignorantly, accomplish his counsel.
Perhaps Ben-hadad only designed to have taken him prisoner, that he
might now give him as honourable a treatment, as he had formerly
received from him.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p19">34. The joints - Where the several parts of his armour
were joined together. The only place about him where this arrow of death
could find entrance. No armour is proof against the darts of divine
vengeance. Case the criminal in steel, and it is all one: he that made
him, can make his sword approach him. And that which to us seems
altogether casual, comes by the determinate counsel of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p20">37. Died - Finding too late the truth of Micaiah's words;
and Zedekiah's horns of iron, pushing not the Syrians, but himself, into
destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p21">39. Ivory house - Not that it was made of solid ivory,
but because the other materials were covered, or inlaid with ivory.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p22">41. Of Ahab - Who reigned twenty two years; therefore he
reigned about eighteen years with Ahab.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p23">43. High places - He took them away, but not fully; or
not in the beginning of of his reign.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p24">44. Made peace - With Ahab first, and then with his son.
This is noted as a blemish in his government, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xix. 2" id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p24.1" parsed="|2Chr|19|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.19.2">2 Chron. xix, 2</scripRef>, and proved of most mischievous consequence to his
posterity.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p25">47. A deputy - Sent, and set over them by the kings of
Judah, from the time of David, until the days of Jehoram, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxi. 8" id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p25.1" parsed="|2Chr|21|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.21.8">2 Chron. xxi, 8</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p26">49. Would not - He did join with Ahaziah before this
time, and before the ships were broken: for the breaking of the ships
mentioned here, is noted to be the effect of his sin, in joining with
Ahaziah, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xx. 37" id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p26.1" parsed="|2Chr|20|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.20.37">2 Chron. xx, 37</scripRef>. And Jehoshaphat being warned and chastised by God for this
sin, would not be persuaded to repeat it.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p27">51. Ahaziah, &amp;c. - Ahaziah was made king by his
father, and reigned in conjunction with him a year or two before Ahab's
death, and as long after it; even as Jehoram the son of Jehoshaphat was
made king by his father in his life-time, which possibly was done in
compliance with Ahab's desire upon marriage of his daughter to
Jehoshaphat's son; and it may be Ahab, to induce him to do so, give him
an example of it, and made his son his partner in the kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p28">52. In the way - Which seems added, to shew, how little
the example of parents, or ancestors, is to be valued where it is
opposed to the will and word of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xii.xxiii.ii-p29">53. His father, &amp;c. - Most unhappy parents, that thus
help to damn their own children's souls!</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE SECOND BOOK OF KINGS" progress="65.86%" prev="ii.xii.xxiii.ii" next="ii.xiii.i" id="ii.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2Kgs" id="ii.xiii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.xiii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE SECOND BOOK OF KINGS</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Second Kings" progress="65.86%" prev="ii.xiii" next="ii.xiii.ii" id="ii.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.i-p1">THE former book of Kings had an illustrious beginning in
the glory of the kingdom of Israel. This has a melancholy conclusion, in
the desolations of the kingdom of Israel first, and then of Judah. Here
is Elijah fetching fire from heaven, and ascending in fire to heaven,
chap. 1, 2. Elisha working many miracles, chap. 3-7. Hazael anointed,
for the correction of Israel, Jehu, for the destruction of the house of
Ahab and of Baal, chap. 8-10. The reigns of several kings, both of Judah
and Israel, chap. 11-16. The captivity of the ten tribes, chap. 17. The
glorious reign of Hezekiah, chap. 18-20. The wicked reign of Manasseh,
and the good one of Josiah, chap. 21-23. The destruction of Jerusalem by
the king of Babylon, chap. 24, 25.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="65.88%" prev="ii.xiii.i" next="ii.xiii.ii.i" id="ii.xiii.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings I" id="ii.xiii.ii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="65.88%" prev="ii.xiii.ii" next="ii.xiii.ii.ii" id="ii.xiii.ii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.i-p1">The rebellion of Moab, ver. 1. The message of Ahaziah to
Baal- zebub, ver.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="65.88%" prev="ii.xiii.ii.i" next="ii.xiii.iii" id="ii.xiii.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p1">2. God's message to him, ver. 3-8. The destruction of the
men sent to seize Elijah, ver. 9-12. He spares the third messenger, and
goes to the king, ver. 13-16. Ahaziah's death, ver. 17; 18.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p2">1. Moab - This had been subdued by David, as Edom was;
and upon the division of his kingdom, Moab was adjoined to that of
Israel, and Edom to that of Judah, each to that kingdom upon which it
bordered. But when the kingdoms of Israel and Judah were weak and
forsaken by God, they took that opportunity to revolt from them; Moab
here, and Edom a little after.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p3">2. Chamber - In which, the lattess might be left to
convey light into the lower room. But the words may be rendered, through
the battlements (or through the lattess in the battlements) of the roof
of the house. Where, standing and looking through, and leaning upon this
lattess, it broke, and he fell down into the court or garden. Baal-zebub
- Properly, the God of flies; an idol so called, because it was supposed
to deliver those people from flies; Jupiter and Hercules were called by
a like name among the Grecians. And it is evident, both from sacred and
prophane histories, That the idol-gods, did sometimes through God's
permission, give the answers; though they were generally observed, even
by the Heathens themselves, to be dark and doubtful.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p4">3. And say - Dost thou not cast contempt on the God of
Israel, as if he were either ignorant of the event of thy disease, or
unable to give thee relief; and as if Baal-zebub had more skill and
power than he?</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p5">5. Why, &amp;c. - Before you have been at Ekron: which he
knew by their quick return.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p6">8. An hairy man - His garment was rough and hairy, such
as were worn by eminent persons in Greece, in ancient times; and were
the proper habit of the prophets. Girdle - As John the baptist also had.
That by his very outward habit, he might represent Elijah, in whose
spirit and power he came.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p7">9. Man of God - So he calls him by way of scorn. Come -
The king commands thee to come to him: which if thou refuseth, I am to
carry thee by force.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p8">10. Let fire, &amp;c. - Elijah did this, not to secure
himself, he could have done that some other way: nor to revenge himself,
for it was not his own cause that he acted in: but to prove his mission,
and to reveal the wrath of God from heaven against the ungodliness and
unrighteousness of men.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p9">11. And said - He discovers more petulancy than the
former; and shews, how little he was moved by the former example.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p10">13. Besought - Expressing both reverence to his person,
and a dread of God's judgments. There is nothing to be got by contending
with God: if we would prevail with him, it must be by supplication. And
those are wise who learn submission from the fatal consequences of
obstinacy in others.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p11">16. He said - To his very face. Nor durst the king lay
hands upon him, being daunted with the prophet's presence, and
confidence; and affrighted by the late dreadful evidence of his power
with God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ii.ii-p12">17. Jehoram - His brother. The son of Jehoshaphat -
Jehoshaphat, in his seventeenth year, when he went to Ahab, and with him
to Ramoth-Gilead, appointed his son Jehoram his vice-roy, and (in case
of his death) his successor. In the second year from that time, when
Jehoram was thus made vice-king in his father's stead; this Jehoram,
Ahab's son, began to reign: and in the fifth year of the reign of this
Jehoram son of Ahab, which was about the twenty- fourth year of
Jehoshaphat's reign, Jehoram son of Jehoshaphat was made king of Judah,
together with his father.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="65.94%" prev="ii.xiii.ii.ii" next="ii.xiii.iii.i" id="ii.xiii.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings II" id="ii.xiii.iii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="65.94%" prev="ii.xiii.iii" next="ii.xiii.iii.ii" id="ii.xiii.iii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.i-p1">Elisha keeps close to Elijah, and walks with him through
Jordan, ver. 1-8. Elijah is taken up, and Elisha laments the loss of
him, ver. 9-12. He divides Jordan, ver. 13, 14. Is acknowledged by the
sons of the prophets, ver. 15. Who send to seek Elijah, ver. 16-18.
Elisha heals the unwholesome waters, ver. 19-22. Destroys the mocking
children, ver. 23-25</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="65.95%" prev="ii.xiii.iii.i" next="ii.xiii.iv" id="ii.xiii.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p1">1. About to take, &amp;c. - It is supposed, (tho' not
expressly revealed) that Elijah flourished about twenty years, before he
was translated, body and soul, to heaven, only undergoing such a change,
as was necessary to qualify him for being an inhabitant in that world of
Spirits. By translating him, God gave in that dark and degenerate age, a
very sensible proof of another life, together with a type of the
ascension of Christ, and the opening of the kingdom of heaven to all
believers.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p2">2. Tarry here - This he desires, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p3">1. That being left alone, he might better
prepare himself for his great change. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p4">2. Out of indulgence to Elisha, that he
might not be overwhelmed with grief at so sad a sight. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p5">3. That he might try his love, and whet his
desire to accompany him; it being highly convenient for God's honour,
that there should be witnesses of so glorious a translation. To Beth-el
- Which was truth, tho' not the whole truth: for he was to go a far
longer journey. But he was first to go to Beth-el, as also to Jericho,
to the schools of the prophets there, that he might comfort, and
strengthen their hearts in God's work, and give them his dying
counsels.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p6">3. And said - This was revealed to some of the sons of
the prophets, and by them to the whole college. In the kingdom of Judah
they had priest and Levites, and the temple service. The want of these
in the kingdom of Israel, God graciously made up by these colleges,
where men were trained up and employed, in the exercises of religion,
and whither good people resorted, to solemnize the appointed feasts,
with prayer and hearing, tho' they had not conveniencies for sacrifice.
From thy head - Hebrew. from above thy head: which phrase may respect,
either, the manner of sitting in schools, where the scholar sat at his
master's feet. Or, the manner of Elijah's translation, which was to be
by a power sent from heaven, to take him up thither. Hold you your peace
- Do not aggravate my grief, nor divert me with any unseasonable
discourses. He speaks as one that was himself, and would have them calm
and sedate, and with awful silence waiting the event.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p7">7. To view - To observe this great event, Elijah's
translation to heaven, which they expected every moment: and whereof
they desired to be spectators, not to satisfy their own curiosity, but
that they might be witnesses of it to others.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p8">8. Smote the waters - These waters of old yielded to the
ark, now to the prophet's mantle; which to those that wanted the ark,
was an equivalent token of God's presence. When God will take his
children to himself, death is the Jordan, which they must pass through.
And they find a way thro' it, a safe and comfortable way. The death of
Christ has divided those waters, that the ransomed of the Lord may pass
over.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p9">9. A double portion - Or, rather double to what the rest
of the sons of the prophets receive at thy request. He alludes to the
double portion of the first-born, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxi. 17" id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Deut|21|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.21.17">Deut. xxi, 17</scripRef>. But though Elisha desired no more, yet God gave him more
than he desired or expected; and he seems to have had a greater portion
of the gifts of God's Spirit, than even Elijah had.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p10">10. A hard thing - A rare and singular blessing, which I
cannot promise thee, which only God can give; and he gives it only when,
and to whom he pleaseth. If thou seest - This sign he proposed, not
without the direction of God's Spirit, that hereby he might engage him
more earnestly to wait, and more fervently to pray for this mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p11">11. A chariot of fire - In this form the angels appeared.
The souls of all the faithful, are carried by an invisible guard of
angels, into the bosom of Abraham. But Elijah being to carry his body
with him, this heavenly guard appeared visibly: Not in an human shape,
tho' so they might have born him in their arms, but in the form of a
chariot and horses, that he may ride in state, may ride in triumph, like
a prince, like a conqueror. See the readiness of the angels to do the
will of God, even in the meanest services for the heirs of salvation!
Thus he who had burned with holy zeal for God and his honour, was now
conveyed in fire into his immediate presence.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p12">12. My father - So he calls him for his fatherly
affection to him, and for his fatherly authority which he had over him,
in which respect the scholars of the prophets are called their sons. He
saw his own condition like that of a fatherless child, and laments it
accordingly. The chariot, &amp;c. - Who by thy example, and counsels,
and prayers, and power with God, didst more for the defense and
preservation of Israel than all their chariots and horses. The
expression alludes to the form of chariots and horses which he had
seen.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p13">13. Which fell - God so ordering it for Elisha's comfort,
and the strengthening of his faith, as a pledge, that together with
Elijah's mantle, his Spirit should rest upon him. And Elijah himself was
gone to a place, where he needed not the mantle, either to adorn him, or
to shelter him from weather, or to wrap his face in.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p14">14. The Lord - Who at Elijah's request divided these
waters, and is as able to do it again.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p15">15. Bowed themselves - They had been trained up in the
schools: Elisha was taken from the plough. Yet, when they perceive, that
God is with him, and that this is the man whom he delights to honour,
they readily submit to him as their head and father, as the people to
Joshua when Moses was dead. "Those that appear to have God's Spirit and
presence with them, ought to have our esteem and best affections,
notwithstanding the meanness of their extraction and education."</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p16">16. Strong men - Able to take such a journey. Lest,
&amp;c. - They thought, either that God had not finally taken him away
from them, but only for a time; or that God had only taken away his
soul, and that his body was cast down into some place, which they
desired to seek, that they might give it an honourable burial.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p17">17. Was ashamed - That is, to deny them any longer, lest
they should think his denial proceeded from a neglect of his master, or
a contempt of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p18">19. Barren - Either it was so originally, at least, as to
that part of the city where the college of the prophets was: or, it
became so from the curse of God inflicted upon it, when Hiel rebuilt it.
However, upon the prophet's care, it grew exceeding fruitful, and
therefore is commended for its fertility in later writers.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p19">20. A new cruse - That there might be no legal pollution
in it which might offend God, and hinder his miraculous operation. Put
salt - A most improper remedy; for salt naturally makes waters brackish,
and lands barren. Hereby therefore he would shew, that this was effected
solely by the Divine power, which could work either without means, or
against them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p20">21. Death - Hurt, or danger, to man or beast, by drinking
of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p21">23. To Beth-el - To the other school of prophets, to
inform them of Elijah's translation, and his succession to the same
office; and to direct, and comfort, and stablish them. Children - Or,
young men: as this Hebrew word often signifies. It is more than probable
they were old enough to discern between good and evil. The city -
Beth-el was the mother-city of idolatry, where the prophets planted
themselves, that they might bear witness against it, and dissuade the
people from it; though, it seems, they had but small success there.
Mocked him - With great petulancy and vehemency, as the word signifies;
deriding both his person and ministry, and that from a prophane contempt
of the true religion, and a passionate love to that idolatry which they
knew he opposed. Go up - Go up into heaven, whither thou pretendest
Elijah is gone. Why didst not thou accompany thy friend and master to
heaven? Bald-head - So they mock his natural infirmity, which is a great
sin. The repetition shews their heartiness and earnestness, that it was
no sudden slip of their tongue, but a scoff proceeding from a rooted
impiety and hatred of God and his prophets. And very probably it was
their usual practice, to jeer the prophets as they went along the
streets, that they might expose them to contempt, and if possible drive
them out of their town. Had the abuse done to Elisha been the first
offense of the kind, they might not have been so severely punished. But
mocking the messengers of the Lord, was one of the crying sins of
Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p22">24. Cursed them - Nor was this punishment too great for
the offense, if it be considered, that their mocking proceeded from a
great malignity of mind against God; that they mocked not only a man,
and an ancient man, whose very age commanded reverence; and a prophet;
but even God himself, and that glorious work of God, the assumption of
Elijah into heaven; that they might be guilty of many other heinous
crimes, which God and the prophet knew; and were guilty of idolatry,
which by God's law deserved death; that the idolatrous parents were
punished in their children; and that, if any of these children were more
innocent, God might have mercy upon their souls, and then this death was
not a misery, but a real blessing to them, that they were taken away
from that education which was most likely to expose them not only to
temporal, but eternal destruction. In the name - Not from any revengeful
passion, but by the motion of God's Spirit, and by God's command and
commission. God did this, partly, for the terror and caution of all
other idolaters and prophane persons who abounded in that place; partly,
to vindicate the honour, and maintain the authority of his prophets; and
particularly, of Elisha, now especially, in the beginning of his sacred
ministry. Children - This Hebrew word signifies not only young children,
but also those who are grown up to maturity, as <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxii. 22" id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p22.1" parsed="|Gen|32|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.32.22">Gen. xxxii, 22</scripRef>, xxxiv, 4, xxxvii, 30, <scripRef passage="Ruth i. 5" id="ii.xiii.iii.ii-p22.2" parsed="|Ruth|1|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ruth.1.5">Ruth i, 5</scripRef>.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="66.12%" prev="ii.xiii.iii.ii" next="ii.xiii.iv.i" id="ii.xiii.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings III" id="ii.xiii.iv-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="66.12%" prev="ii.xiii.iv" next="ii.xiii.iv.ii" id="ii.xiii.iv.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.i-p1">The character of Jehoram, ver. 1-3. He and his allies
invade Moab, ver. 4-8. Their distress and relief, ver. 9-20. Their
success, ver. 21-25. The king of Moab sacrifices his son, and they
retire, ver. 26, 27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="66.12%" prev="ii.xiii.iv.i" next="ii.xiii.v" id="ii.xiii.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p1">3. The sins - The worship of the calves: which all the
kings of Israel kept up as a wall of partition between their subjects
and those of Judah. So that altho' he had a little religion, yet he had
not enough to over-rule this policy.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p2">4. A sheep-master - A man of great wealth (which in those
times and places consisted much in cattle) which enabled and emboldened
him to rebel against his sovereign.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p3">7. He said - He joins with him in this war; because the
war was just in itself, and convenient for Jehoshaphat, both in the
general, that revolters should be chastised: lest the examples should
pass into his dominions, and the Edomites be encouraged to revolt from
him, as they did from his son; and in particular, that the Moabites
should be humbled, who had invaded his land before this time, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xx. 1" id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p3.1" parsed="|2Chr|20|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.20.1">2 Chron. xx, 1</scripRef>, and might do so again if they were not brought low; for
which a fair opportunity now offered.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p4">9. King of Edom - That is, the vice-roy under Jehosaphat,
<scripRef passage="1 Kings xxii. 47" id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Kgs|22|47|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.22.47">1 Kings
xxii, 47</scripRef>, here called king: because that word is sometimes used for
any prince or chief ruler. Seven days - Because they made a great army,
which could move but slowly; and they fetched a greater compass than was
usual, for some advantage which they expected by it. No water - A
frequent want in those parts; and now, it seems, increased by the
extraordinary heat and dryness of the season.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p5">11. Is there not, &amp;c. - This he should have asked
before, when they first undertook the expedition, as he did in a like
case, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xxii. 5" id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p5.1" parsed="|1Kgs|22|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.22.5">1
Kings xxii, 5</scripRef>, and for that neglect he now suffers; but better late than
never: his affliction brings him to the remembrance of his former sin,
and present duty. Poured water - Who was his servant; this being one
office of a servant: and this office was the more necessary among the
Israelites, because of the frequent washings which their law required.
Probably it was by a special direction from God, that Elisha followed
them, unasked, unobserved. Thus does God prevent us with the blessings
of his goodness; and provide for those who provide not for
themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p6">12. The word, &amp;c. - He is a true prophet. Which
Jehoshaphat might easily understand, because being a good man, many
would be ready to inform him of. Went - To his tent; which was either in
the camp, or not far from it: they did not send for him, but went to
him, that by giving him this honour, they might engage him to give them
his utmost assistance.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p7">13. What have I, &amp;c. - I desire to have no discourse
with thee. Get thee - To the calves, which thou after thy father's
example dost worship; and to the Baals which thy mother yet worshippeth
by thy permission; let these idols whom thou worshippest in thy
prosperity, now help thee in thy distress.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p8">14. Jehoshaphat - Whom I reverence and love for his
piety. It is good being with those who have God's favour, and the love
of his people. Wicked men often fare the better, for the friendship and
society of good men.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p9">15. Minstrel - One that can sing and play upon a musical
instrument. This he requires, that his mind which had been disturbed at
the sight of wicked Jehoram, might be composed, and that he might be
excited to more fervent prayer whereby he was prepared to receive the
prophetic inspiration. Those that desire communion with God must keep
their spirits quiet and serene. All hurry of spirit, and all turbulent
passions, make us unfit for divine visitations. The hand, &amp;c. - The
spirit of prophecy, so called, to note that it was no natural nor
acquired virtue inherent in him; but a singular gift of God, given to
whom and when he pleased.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p10">19. Ye shall smite - And if this command seem severe, it
must be considered, that the Moabites were a very wicked people,
perfidious, cruel, implacable enemies to God's people upon all
occasions, and now in a state of rebellion.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p11">20. The meal-offering - That is, the morning sacrifice:
which doubtless was attended with the solemn prayers of God's people. At
this time Elisha joined his prayers with the prayers of God's people,
especially those at Jerusalem. And this time God chose to answer their
prayers, and to work this miracle, that thereby he might determine the
controversy between the Israelites and the Jews, about the place and
manner of worship, and give a publick testimony from heaven for the
Jews, and against the Israelites. God that commands all the waters both
above and beneath the firmament, sent them abundance of water on a
sudden.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p12">21. The border - Of their country, to defend the
passage.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p13">25. Kir-haraseth - This was the royal city of the
Moabites, into which the remnant of the Moabites were gathered, where
also their king was with them. The stones - The walls and buildings of
this city only were left; their whole country being destroyed. The
slingers - Such as slung great stones against the walls to break them
down, according to the manner of those times. Made breaches in the
walls, by which they might enter the city, and take it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p14">26. To break thro' - That he might make an escape: which
he chose to do on the king of Edom's quarter; because he thought his was
the weakest side.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.iv.ii-p15">27. His son - Or rather, his own son: whom he sacrificed;
partly, to obtain the favour of his God, according to the manner of the
Phoenicians and other people in publick calamities; and partly, to
oblige the Israelites to quit the siege out of compassion; or, as
despairing to conquer (at least without greater loss of men than it was
worth) him who was resolved to defend the city to the utmost extremity.
On the wall - That the besiegers might see it, and be moved by it. There
was, &amp;c. - Or, great trouble or repentance upon Israel, the
Israelitish king and people (who was the first cause of the war, and had
brought the rest into confederacy with him) were greatly grieved for
this barbarous action, and resolved to prosecute the war no farther.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="66.23%" prev="ii.xiii.iv.ii" next="ii.xiii.v.i" id="ii.xiii.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings IV" id="ii.xiii.v-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="66.23%" prev="ii.xiii.v" next="ii.xiii.v.ii" id="ii.xiii.v.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.v.i-p1">Elisha multiplies the widow's oil, ver. 1-7. Obtains a
son for the Shunamite, ver. 8-17. Raises him again to life, ver. 18-37.
Heals the deadly pottage, ver. 38-41. Feeds an hundred men with twenty
small loaves, ver. 42-44.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="66.23%" prev="ii.xiii.v.i" next="ii.xiii.vi" id="ii.xiii.v.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p1">1. Prophets - Who, though they were wholly devoted to
sacred employment, were not excluded from marriage, any more than the
priests and Levites. Fear the Lord - His poverty therefore was not
procured by his idleness, or prodigality; but by his piety, because he
would not comply with the king's way of worship, and therefore lost all
worldly advantages. Bondmen - Either, to use them as his slaves, or to
sell them to others, according to the law.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p2">2. What shall I - How shall I relieve thee, who am myself
poor?</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p3">7. Unto her son - To one of them: for she had two, ver.
1. The oil stayed - To teach us, that we should not waste any of his
good creatures; and that God would not work miracles unnecessarily. We
are never straiten'd in God, and in his power and bounty, and the riches
of his grace. All our straitness is in ourselves. It is our faith that
fails, not his promise. Were there more vessels, there is enough in God
to fill them, enough for all, enough for each.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p4">8. Great - For estate, or birth and quality.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p5">9. This is - A prophet, and that of eminent holiness: by
our kindness to whom, we shall procure a blessing to ourselves.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p6">10. On the wall - That he may be free from the noise of
family business, and enjoy that privacy, which, I perceive, he desireth
for his prayers and meditations. A bed, &amp;c. - He will not be
troublesome or chargeable to us: he cares not for rich furniture or
costly entertainment, and is content with bare necessaries.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p7">12. She stood - The relation seems to be a little
perplexed, but may be thus conceived. It is in this verse recorded in
the general, that the prophet sent Gehazi to call her, and that she came
to him upon that call: then follows a particular description of the
whole business, with all the circumstances, first, of the message with
which Gehazi was sent when he went to call her, and of her answer to
that message, ver. 13, and of Gehazi's conjecture thereupon, ver. 14,
and then of her coming to the prophet at his call: which is there
repeated to make way for the following passages.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p8">13. I dwell - I live among my kindred and friends; nor
have I any cause to seek relief from higher powers.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p9">14. He said - Hast thou observed any thing which she
wants or desires? For the prophet kept himself much in his chamber,
whilst Gehazi went more freely about the house, as his occasions led
him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p10">16. Do not lie - Do not delude me with vain hopes. She
could not believe it for joy.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p11">17. Time of life - See note on <scripRef passage="Gen. xviii. 10" id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Gen|18|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.18.10">Gen. xviii, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p12">21. Bed of the man of God - Being apt to believe, he that
so soon took away what he had given, would restore what he had taken
away. By this faith women received their dead raised to life. In this
faith she makes no preparation for the burial of her child, but for his
resurrection.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p13">23. New moon, &amp;c. - Which were the usual times in
which they resorted to the prophets for instruction. It shall be well -
My going will not be troublesome to him, nor prejudicial to thee or
me.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p14">26. It is - So it was in some respects, because it was
the will of a wise and good God, and therefore best for her. When God
calls away our dearest relations by death, it becomes us to say, it is
well both with us and them. It is well, for all is well that God doth:
all is well with them that are gone, if they are gone to heaven. And all
is well with us that stay behind, if by the affliction we are furthered
in our way thither.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p15">27. The feet - She fell at his feet and touched them, as
a most humble and earnest supplicant. Withal, she intimated, what she
durst not presume to express in words, that she desired him to go along
with her. Let her alone - Disturb her not, for this gesture is a sign of
some extraordinary grief. Hid it - Whereby he signifies, that what he
knew or did, was not by any virtue inherent in himself, but from God,
who revealed to him only what and when he pleased.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p16">28. She said - This child was not given to me upon my
immoderate desire, for which I might have justly been thus chastised,
but was freely promised by thee in God's name, and from his special
favour. Deceive me - With vain hopes of a comfort that I should never
have. And I had been much happier if I had never had it, than to lose it
so quickly.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p17">29. Gird up - Tie up thy long garments about thy loins
for expedition. If thou meet, &amp;c. - Make no delay nor stop by the
way, neither by words nor actions.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p18">30. Will not leave thee - Until thou goest home with me.
For she had no great confidence in Gehazi, nor was her faith so strong
as to think that the prophet could work so great a miracle at this
distance.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p19">31. Neither voice - Neither speech, nor sense, nor any
sign of life, in the child. This disappointment might proceed from
hence, that Elisha having changed his mind, and yielded to her
importunity to go with her, did alter his course, and not join his
fervent prayers with Gehazi's action. Not awaked - Not revived.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p20">33. Shut the door - Upon himself and the dead child, that
he might pray to God without distraction, and might more freely use
those means which he thought fit.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p21">34. And put - One part upon another successively; for the
disproportion of the bodies would not permit it to be done together.
Grew warm - Not by any external heat, which could not be transmitted to
the child's body by such slight touches of the prophet's body; but from
a principle of life, which was already infused into the child, and by
degrees enlivened all the parts of his body.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p22">35. He walked - He changeth his postures for his own
necessary refreshment, and walked to and fro, exercising his mind in
prayer to God. And went - Repeating his former actions, to teach us not
to be discouraged in our prayers, if we be not speedily answered. Opened
his eyes - So the work begun in the former verse is here perfected.
Although miracles were for the most part done in an instant, yet
sometimes they were done by degrees.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p23">36. Unto him - To the door.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p24">40. Death - That is, some deadly thing.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p25">41. Into the pot - Together with the pottage which they
had taken out of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p26">42. First fruits - Which were the priests due, <scripRef passage="Num. xviii. 12" id="ii.xiii.v.ii-p26.1" parsed="|Num|18|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.18.12">Num. xviii, 12</scripRef>, but these, and probably the rest of the priests dues, were
usually brought by the pious Israelites, according to their ability and
opportunity, to the Lord's prophets, because they were not permitted to
carry them to Jerusalem.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="66.34%" prev="ii.xiii.v.ii" next="ii.xiii.vi.i" id="ii.xiii.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings V" id="ii.xiii.vi-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="66.34%" prev="ii.xiii.vi" next="ii.xiii.vi.ii" id="ii.xiii.vi.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.i-p1">Naaman hears of Elisha, ver. 1-4. The king of Syria sends
him to the king of Israel, ver. 5-7. He goes to Elisha and is healed,
ver. 8-14. His grateful acknowledgment to Elisha, ver. 15-19. Gehazi
follows him, and receives gifts from him, ver. 20-24. The leprosy of
Naaman entailed on Gehazi's family, ver. 25-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="66.35%" prev="ii.xiii.vi.i" next="ii.xiii.vii" id="ii.xiii.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p1">5. Go to, &amp;c. - It was very natural for a king to
suppose, that the king of Israel could do more than any of his
subjects.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p2">10. Elisha sent - Which he did, partly, to exercise
Naaman's faith and obedience: partly, for the honour of his religion,
that it might appear he sought not his own glory and profit, but only
God's honour, and the good of men.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p3">11. Was wroth - Supposing himself despised by the
prophet.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p4">12. Are not, &amp;c. - Is there not as great a virtue in
them to this purpose? But he should have considered, that the cure was
not to be wrought by the water, but by the power of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p5">13. My father - Or, our father. So they call him, to shew
their reverence and affection to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p6">16. He refused - Not that he thought it unlawful to
receive presents, which he did receive from others, but because of the
special circumstances of the case; this being much for the honour of God
that the Syrians should see the generous piety, and kindness of his
ministers and servants, and how much they despised all that worldly
wealth and glory, which the prophets of the Gentiles so greedily sought
after.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p7">17. Two mules burden of earth - So he seems to farm the
money which he brought with him, to express how little value he now set
upon it. Ten talents (above three thousand five hundred pounds) in
silver, with six thousand pieces of gold, (beside ten changes of
raiment) were a burden for several mules. Shall I not give this to thy
servant, Gehazi, if thou thyself will accept of nothing? This seems a
more probable interpretation than the common one, that he wanted to
build an altar therewith. For what altar could be built of the earth
which two mules could carry into Syria? Unless they were as large and as
strong as Elephants.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p8">18. Rimmon - A Syrian idol, called here by the LXX,
Remman, and <scripRef passage="Acts vii. 43" id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Acts|7|43|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.7.43">Acts vii, 43</scripRef>, Remphan. My hand - Or, arm, upon which, the king leaned,
either for state, or for support.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p9">20. Gehazi - One would expect Elisha's servant should
have been a saint: but we find him far otherwise. The best men, the best
ministers, have often had those about them, that were their grief and
shame. This Syrian - A stranger, and one of that nation who are the
implacable enemies of God's people. As the Lord - He swears, that he
might have some pretense for the action to which he had bound himself by
his oath; not considering, that to swear to do any wicked action, is so
far from excusing it, that it makes it much worse.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p10">23. Urged him - Who at first refused it upon a pretense
of modesty.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p11">26. Olive yards, &amp;c. - Which Gehazi intended to
purchase with this money: and therefore the prophet names them, to
inform him, that he exactly knew, not only his outward actions, but even
his most secret intentions. What a folly is it, to presume upon sin in
hopes of secrecy? When thou goest aside into any bye-path, doth not thy
own conscience go with thee? Nay, doth not the eye of God go with thee?
What then avails the absence of human witnesses?</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p12">27. For ever - That is, for some generations; as that
word is often used and as may be thought by comparing this with <scripRef passage="Exod. xx. 55" id="ii.xiii.vi.ii-p12.1" parsed="|Exod|20|55|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.20.55">Exod. xx, 55</scripRef>. (?) White - Which is the worst kind of leprosy, and noted
by physicians to be incurable. Those who get money by any way
displeasing to God, make a dear purchase. What was Gehazi profited by
his two talents, when he lost his health, if not his soul, forever?</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="66.41%" prev="ii.xiii.vi.ii" next="ii.xiii.vii.i" id="ii.xiii.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings VI" id="ii.xiii.vii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="66.41%" prev="ii.xiii.vii" next="ii.xiii.vii.ii" id="ii.xiii.vii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.i-p1">Elisha causes iron to swim, ver. 1-7. Discloses to the
king of Israel the secret counsels of the king of Syria, ver. 8-12.
Saves himself out of the hands of those who were sent to apprehend him,
ver. 13-23. Samaria is besieged by the Syrians, and reduced to
extremity, ver. 24-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="66.41%" prev="ii.xiii.vii.i" next="ii.xiii.viii" id="ii.xiii.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p1">2. Jordan - To the woods near Jordan. A beam - A piece of
timber for the building. Hence it may be gathered, that although the
sons of the prophets principally devoted themselves to religious
exercises, yet they sometimes employed themselves about manual arts.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p2">10. Sent - Soldiers to secure the place and passage
designed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p3">16. They - Angels, unspeakably more numerous, God,
infinitely more powerful.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p4">17. He saw, &amp;c. - Fire is both dreadful and
devouring: that power which was engaged for Elisha, could both terrify
and consume the assailants. Elijah gave a specimen of Divine justice,
when he called for flames of fire on the heads of his persecutors to
consume them. Elisha gives a specimen of Divine mercy, in heaping coals
of fire on the heads of his persecutors to melt them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p5">22. Wouldest thou smite - It is against the laws of
humanity, to kill captives, though thou thyself hast taken them with thy
own sword and bow; which might seem to give thee some colour to destroy
them; but much more unworthy will it be in cold blood to kill these,
whom not thy arms, but God's providence hath put into thy hands. Set
bread - Give them meat and drink, which may refresh and strengthen them
for their journey. This was an action of singular piety and charity, in
doing good to their enemies, which was much to the honour of the true
religion; and of no less prudence, that hereby the hearts of the Syrians
might be mollified towards the Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p6">23. No more - For some considerable time.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p7">24. Ben-hadad - He whom Ahab wickedly spared, now comes
to requite his kindness, and to fulfil that Divine prediction. Ben-
hadad was a name very frequent among the kings of Syria, if not common
to them all.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p8">25. Famine in Samaria - Probably the siege was so sudden,
that they had no time to lay in provisions. Pieces - Supposed to be
shekels; and the common shekel being valued at fifteen pence of English
money, this amounts to five pounds. A vast price, especially for that
which had on it so little meat, and that unwholesome and unclean. A kab
- A measure containing twenty- four eggs. Dung - This Hebrew word is of
a doubtful signification, and no where else used, probably it means a
sort of pease, which in the Arabick language (near a-kin to the Hebrew)
is called doves dung: for this was a food much in use amongst the poorer
Israelites, and was a very coarse food, and therefore fit to be joined
with the asses head: and a kab was the usual measure of all sorts of
grains and fruits of that sort.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p9">27. Whence shall I help thee - Dost thou ask of me corn
or wine, which I want for myself? If God does not, I cannot help thee.
Creatures are helpless things without God. Every creature is all that,
and only that which God makes it to be.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p10">29. We boiled - A dreadful judgment threatened to them in
case of their apostacy, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxviii. 56, 57" id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Deut|28|56|28|57" osisRef="Bible:Deut.28.56-Deut.28.57">Deut. xxviii, 56, 57</scripRef>, in which they were now deeply plunged.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p11">31. God do so, &amp;c. - Because he had encouraged them
to withstand the Syrians, by promising them help from God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p12">32. He said - Being admonished by God of his danger. This
son - The genuine son of that wicked Ahab the murderer of the Lord's
prophets. This expression may seem very harsh and unfit; nor is it to be
drawn into imitation by others: but it must be considered, that he was
an extraordinary prophet, intrusted with a power in some sort superior
to that of Joram, and had authority to control and rebuke him in the
name of the king of kings. Hold him - That he may not break in upon me,
and take away my life, before the king comes.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.vii.ii-p13">33. He said - Or, the king, who, though not here named,
may be presumed to be present, both by the prophet's prediction of his
speedy coming, and by the presence of the Lord, on whose hand the king
leaned, chap. vii, 2. This evil - This dreadful famine, which is now so
extreme, that women are forced to eat their own children. The Lord -
Hath inflicted it, and (for ought I see) he will not remove it. All
penal evil is of the Lord, as the first cause and sovereign judge. And
this we ought to apply to particular cases: if all evil, then this evil
which we are groaning under. Whoever are the instruments, God is the
principal agent. What should I, &amp;c. - Thou bidst me wait upon God
for help: but I perceive I may wait long enough before deliverance
comes: I am weary with waiting, I can wait no longer.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="66.49%" prev="ii.xiii.vii.ii" next="ii.xiii.viii.i" id="ii.xiii.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings VII" id="ii.xiii.viii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="66.49%" prev="ii.xiii.viii" next="ii.xiii.viii.ii" id="ii.xiii.viii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.viii.i-p1">Elisha foretells plenty, and the death of the unbelieving
Lord, ver. 1, 2. Four lepers discover that the Syrians are fled, and
bring the news into the city, ver. 3-11. The king sends messengers in
order to be assured of the truth, ver. 12-15. Sudden plenty and the
death of the unbelieving Lord, ver. 16-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="66.49%" prev="ii.xiii.viii.i" next="ii.xiii.ix" id="ii.xiii.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.viii.ii-p1">1. Measure - Hebrew. Seah, a measure containing six cabs,
or about a peck and pottle of our measure.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.viii.ii-p2">2. Windows - Through which he could rain down corn, as
once he did Manna.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.viii.ii-p3">6. Hittites - Under which name (as elsewhere under the
name of the Amorites) he seems to understand all the people of Canaan.
For though the greatest number of that people were destroyed, yet very
many of them were spared, and many of them upon Joshua's coming, fled
away, some to remote parts, others to the lands bordering upon Canaan,
where they seated themselves, and grew numerous and powerful. Kings -
Either the king of Egypt, the plural number being put for the singular,
or, the princes and governors of the several provinces in Egypt.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.viii.ii-p4">7. Fled - None of them had so much sense as to send
scouts to discover the supposed enemy, much less, courage enough to face
them. God can when he pleases, dispirit the boldest, and make the
stoutest heart to tremble. They that will not fear God, he can make them
fear at the shaking of a leaf. Perhaps Gehazi was one of these lepers,
which might occasion his being taken notice of by the king, chap. viii,
4.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.viii.ii-p5">13. Behold, &amp;c. - The words may be rendered, Behold,
they are of a truth (the Hebrew prefix, Caph, being not here a note of
similitude, but an affirmation of the truth and certainty of the things,
as it is taken <scripRef passage="Num. xi. 1" id="ii.xiii.viii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Num|11|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.11.1">Num. xi, 1</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Deut. ix. 10" id="ii.xiii.viii.ii-p5.2" parsed="|Deut|9|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.9.10">Deut. ix, 10</scripRef>,) all the multitude of the horses of Israel that are left in
it: behold, I say, they are even all the multitude of the horses of the
Israelites, which (which multitude) are consumed, reduced to this small
number, all consumed except these five. And this was indeed worthy of a
double behold, to shew what mischief the famine had done both upon men
and beasts, and to what a low ebb the king of Israel was come, that all
his troops of horses, to which he had trusted, were shrunk to so small a
number.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.viii.ii-p6">20. And so it fell out, &amp;c. - See how heinously God
resents our distrust of his power, providence and promise! Whenever God
promises the end, he knows where to provide the means.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="66.53%" prev="ii.xiii.viii.ii" next="ii.xiii.ix.i" id="ii.xiii.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings VIII" id="ii.xiii.ix-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="66.53%" prev="ii.xiii.ix" next="ii.xiii.ix.ii" id="ii.xiii.ix.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.i-p1">Elisha's advice to the Shunamite, ver. 1, 2. The king
restores her land, ver. 3-6. Elisha's prophecy to Hazael, and the death
of Ben-hadad, ver. 7-15. The reign of Jehoram, ver. 16-24. Succeeded by
Ahaziah, ver. 25-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="66.53%" prev="ii.xiii.ix.i" next="ii.xiii.x" id="ii.xiii.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p1">1. Sojourn - In any convenient place out of the land of
Israel. The Lord, &amp;c. - Hath appointed to bring a famine. This
expression intimates, that all afflictions are sent by God, and come at
his call or command. Seven years - A double time to the former famine
under Elijah, which is but just, because they were still incorrigible
under all the judgments of God, and the powerful ministry of Elisha.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p2">3. Her house - Which having been forsaken by her, were
possessed by her kindred.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p3">4. Gehazi the servant - Formerly his servant. The law did
not forbid conversing with lepers, but only dwelling with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p4">8. Inquire of the Lord,&amp;c. - In his health he bowed
down in the house of Rimmon; but now he tends to inquire of the God of
Israel. Among other instances of the change of mens minds by affliction
or sickness, this is one; that it often gives them other thoughts of
God's ministers, and teacheth them to value those whom they before hated
and despised.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p5">9. Thy son - He who before persecuted him as an enemy,
now in his extremity honours him like a father.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p6">10. Howbeit - Here is no contradiction: for the first
words contain an answer to Benhadad's question, shall I recover? To
which the answer is, thou mayest, notwithstanding thy disease, which is
not mortal. The latter words contain the prophet's addition to that
answer, which is, that he should die, not by the power of his disease,
but by some other cause.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p7">11. He settled - The prophet fixed his eyes upon Hazael.
Until - 'Till Hazael was ashamed, as apprehending the prophet discerned
something of an evil and shameful nature in him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p8">13. A dog - So fierce, barbarous, and inhuman. King - And
when thou shalt have power in thy hand, thou wilt discover that bloody
disposition, and that hatred against God's people, which now lies hid
from others, and possibly from thyself.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p9">15. Spread it - So closely, that he choaked him
therewith.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p10">16. Jehoram - Jehoram was first made king or vice-roy, by
his father divers years before this time, at his expedition to Ramoth-
Gilead, which dominion of his, ended at his father's return. But now
Jehoshaphat, being not far from his death, and having divers sons and
fearing some competition among them, makes Jehoram king the second time,
as David did Solomon upon the like occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p11">18. He walked - After his father's death. The daughter -
Athaliah. This unequal marriage, though Jehoshaphat possibly designed it
as a means of uniting the two kingdoms under one head, is here and
elsewhere noted, as the cause both of the great wickedness of his
posterity, and of those sore calamities which befel them. No good could
be reasonably expected from such an union. Those that are ill matched
are already half-ruined.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p12">19. Alway - Until the coming of the Messiah: for so long,
and not longer, this succession might seem necessary for the making good
of God's promise and covenant made with David. But when the Messiah, was
once come, there was no more need of any succession, and the scepter
might and did without any inconvenience depart from Judah, and from all
the succeeding branches of David's family, because the Messiah was to
hold the kingdom forever in his own person, though not in so gross a way
as the carnal Jews imagined. A light - A son and successor.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.ix.ii-p13">29. Ramah - The same place with Ramoth, or
Ramoth-Gilead.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="66.59%" prev="ii.xiii.ix.ii" next="ii.xiii.x.i" id="ii.xiii.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings IX" id="ii.xiii.x-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="66.59%" prev="ii.xiii.x" next="ii.xiii.x.ii" id="ii.xiii.x.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.x.i-p1">A prophet commissions Jehu to take upon him the
government, and destroy the house of Ahab, ver. 1-10. Jehu communicates
this to his captains, ver. 11-15. Marches to Jezreel, ver. 16-20. Kills
Joram, ver. 21-26. Ahaziah, ver. 27-29. And Jezebel, ver. 30-37.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="66.60%" prev="ii.xiii.x.i" next="ii.xiii.xi" id="ii.xiii.x.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p1">1. Ramoth - The kings of Israel and Judah were both
absent, and Jehu, as it seems, was left in chief command.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p2">7. I may avenge,&amp;c. - That they were idolaters was
bad enough: yet that is not mentioned here: the controversy God has with
them, is for being persecutors. Nothing fills the measure of the
iniquity of any prince so as this doth, nor brings a surer or sorer
ruin.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p3">11. Mad fellow - They perceived him to be a prophet by
his habit, and gestures, and manner of speech. And these prophane
soldiers esteemed the prophets mad-men. Those that have no religion,
commonly speak of those that are religious with disdain, and look upon
them as crack-brained. They said of our Lord, He is beside himself; of
St. Paul, that much learning had made him mad. The highest wisdom is
thus represented as folly, and they that best understand themselves, as
men beside themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p4">13. They hasted - God putting it into their hearts thus
readily to own him. Under him - Under Jehu. A ceremony used in the
eastern parts towards superiors, in token of reverence to his person,
that they would not have his feet to touch the ground, and that they put
themselves and their concerns under his feet, and into his disposal. The
stairs - In some high and eminent place, whence he might be seen and
owned by all the soldiers, who were called together upon this great
occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p5">21. Portion of Naboth - The very sight of that ground was
enough to make Jehu triumph and Joram tremble. The circumstances of
events are sometimes so ordered by Divine providence, as to make the
punishment answer the sin, as face answers face in a glass.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p6">22. Whoredoms, &amp;c. - This may be understood, either
literally; spiritual whoredom, which is idolatry, being often punished
with corporal: and witchcraft was often practiced by idolaters: or
spiritually, of her idolatry, which is often called whoredom, because it
is a departing from God, to whom we are tied by many obligations; and
witchcraft, because it doth so powerfully bewitch men's minds; and
because it is a manifest entering into covenant with the devil. He
mentions not Joram's, but his mother's sins; because they were more
notorious and infamous: and because they were the principal cause why
God inflicted, and he was come to execute these judgments. The way of
sin can never be the way of peace.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p7">24. The arrow - It was one of God's arrows, which he
ordained against the persecutor.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p8">27. He died - The history is briefly and imperfectly
described here, and the defects supplied in (the book of Chronicles, is
great part written for that end, to supply things omitted in the book of
Kings) out of both it may be thus compleated: he fled first to Megiddo,
and thence to Samaria, where he was caught, and thence brought to Jehu,
and by his sentence was put to death at Megiddo.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p9">31. Had Zimri - Remember thy brother traitor Zimri had
but a very short enjoyment of the benefit of his treason.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.x.ii-p10">34. And said - It seems he had forgot the charge given
him above, ver. 10. A king's daughter - He doth not say, because she was
a king's wife, lest he should seem to shew any respect to that wicked
house of Ahab, which God had devoted to utter destruction.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="66.65%" prev="ii.xiii.x.ii" next="ii.xiii.xi.i" id="ii.xiii.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings X" id="ii.xiii.xi-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="66.65%" prev="ii.xiii.xi" next="ii.xiii.xi.ii" id="ii.xiii.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.i-p1">Jehu cuts off all Ahab's sons, ver. 1-10. And kindred,
ver. 11- 14. Takes Jehonadab with him, ver. 11-17. Slays the worshippers
of Baal, ver. 18-25. Abolishes his worship, ver. 26-28. Yet retains the
worship of the Calves, ver. 29-31. Which God punishes by Hazael, ver.
32-33. Jehu's death, ver. 34-37</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="66.66%" prev="ii.xiii.xi.i" next="ii.xiii.xii" id="ii.xiii.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p1">5. The house - The chief governor of the kings palace.
City - The chief magistrate or military governor.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p2">7. Sent them - Jehu justly required this, because the
sovereign Lord of all mens lives commanded it, but the Samaritans
wickedly obeyed it, without any knowledge of, or regard to God's
command.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p3">11. Left none - In that place and kingdom; for he did
leave some of the royal seed of Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p4">15. Rechab - A Kenite, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. ii. 55" id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Chr|2|55|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.2.55">1 Chron. ii, 55</scripRef>, and a man of singular prudence and piety. Coming - To
congratulate with him, for the destruction of that wicked family; and to
encourage him to proceed in fulfilling the will of God. Him - Jehu
saluted Jehonadab. Is, &amp;c. - Dost thou heartily approve of me, and
my present proceedings.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p5">18. Jehu said - The words being manifestly false, and
spoken with a design to deceive, cannot be excused, this being an
unmovable principle, That we must not do the least evil, that the
greatest good may come.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p6">25. City - To some buildings belonging to this house of
Baal, which may be here called the city; because they were very numerous
and capacious. For as there were divers chambers and rooms built without
the temple, belonging to it, for the use of the priests, and Levites. So
it may probably be conceived, That this famous temple of Baal had many
such buildings; in some of which, the priests of Baal, or of the groves,
(whereof there were great numbers belonging to the king's court, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xviii. 19" id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p6.1" parsed="|1Kgs|18|19|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.18.19">1 Kings xviii, 19</scripRef>,) peradventure might dwell; and others of them might be for
divers uses belonging to the house, and service of Baal.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p7">27. Draught-house - A sink or common shore.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p8">29. Jehu departed not - So that it is plain, his religion
was but superficial: otherwise it would not have given way to his
policy.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p9">30. Done well - In part, and so far as is here
expressed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xi.ii-p10">31. Took no heed - Sin, clearly shewed that his heart was
not right with God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="66.69%" prev="ii.xiii.xi.ii" next="ii.xiii.xii.i" id="ii.xiii.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XI" id="ii.xiii.xii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="66.69%" prev="ii.xiii.xii" next="ii.xiii.xii.ii" id="ii.xiii.xii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.i-p1">Athaliah usurps the government and destroys all the seed
royal; only Joash escapes, ver. 1-3. He is made king, ver. 4-12.
Athaliah is slain, ver. 13-16. Joash reigns well, ver. 17-21.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="66.70%" prev="ii.xiii.xii.i" next="ii.xiii.xiii" id="ii.xiii.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p1">1. She destroyed - This was the fruit of Jehoshaphat's
marrying his son to a daughter of that idolatrous house of Ahab. And
this dreadful judgment God permitted upon him and his, to shew how much
he abhors all such affinities.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p2">2. They hid - Jehosheba and her husband Jehoiada.
Bed-chamber - Which was in the house of the Lord. So that it was one of
those chambers adjoining to the temple, that were for the uses of the
priests and Levites only: which made it more proper for this purpose.
Now was the promise made to David bound up in one life. And yet it did
not fail. Thus to the Son of David will God, according to his promise,
secure a spiritual seed: which tho' sometimes reduced to a small number,
brought very low, and seemingly lost, yet will be preserved to the end
of time. It was a special providence that Joram tho' a king, a wicked
king, married his daughter to Jehoiada, a priest, an holy priest. This
some might think a disparagement to the royal family; but it saved the
royal family from ruin. For Jehoiada's interest in the temple, gave her
an opportunity to preserve the child: and her interest in the royal
family, gave him an opportunity of setting him on the throne. See what
blessings they lay up in store for their families who marry their
children to those that are wise and good.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p3">4. The house - Into the courts of that house, for into
the house none but the priests or Levites might enter.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p4">5. Of you - Levites, who were distributed into twenty
four courses, to minister in turns, each course consisting of about a
thousand men for a week. Enter in - That come into the temple to attend
your ministry. King's house - Of that part which lead to the king's
palace, which Athaliah now possessed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p5">6. Sur - The chief gate of the temple. The guard -
Either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p6">1. the king's guard. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p7">2. the guard of the temple; this gate was
in the south-side. So, &amp;c. - So you shall guard all the gates or
entrances into the temple that neither Athaliah nor any of her soldiers
may break in.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p8">7. That go, &amp;c. - Who having finished their course,
should have gone home, but were detained, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxiii. 8" id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|2Chr|23|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.23.8">2 Chron. xxiii, 8</scripRef>. Shall keep - While the rest guard the entrances into the
temple; these shall have a special care of the king's person.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p9">8. Ranges - Or, fences, the wall wherewith the courts of
the temple were environed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p10">12. Testimony - The book of the law, which he put into
the king's hand, to mind him of his duty at his entrance upon his
kingdom, which was to read and write out that holy book, <scripRef passage="Deut. xvii. 18" id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Deut|17|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.17.18">Deut. xvii, 18</scripRef>, and to govern himself and his kingdom by it: the law of God
being frequently and most properly called a testimony, because it is a
witness of God's will, and man's duty.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p11">15. Host - Of these companies of Levites, who are
elsewhere called the Lord's host, and now were the king's host.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xii.ii-p12">17. A covenant - A sacred covenant whereby he solemnly
engaged both the king, and people, that they should be the Lord's
people; that they should renounce, and root out all idolatry, and set up
and maintain God's true worship. Between the king - This was a civil
covenant, whereby the king engaged himself to rule them justly, and in
the fear of God; and the people obliged themselves to defend and obey
him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="66.75%" prev="ii.xiii.xii.ii" next="ii.xiii.xiii.i" id="ii.xiii.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XII" id="ii.xiii.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="66.75%" prev="ii.xiii.xiii" next="ii.xiii.xiii.ii" id="ii.xiii.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xiii.i-p1">Jehoash reigns well while Jehoiada lives, ver. 1-3.
Repairs the temple, ver. 4-16. Compounds with Hazael, ver. 17, 18. Dies
ingloriously, ver. 19-21.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="66.76%" prev="ii.xiii.xiii.i" next="ii.xiii.xiv" id="ii.xiii.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xiii.ii-p1">3. Burnt incense - To the true God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiii.ii-p2">4. And Jehoash said, &amp;c. - Remembering that he owed
his preservation and restoration to the temple, and that he was made by
God the guardian of his temple, he now takes care to repair it.
Dedicated things - The money which had been either formerly or lately
vowed or dedicated to the service of God and of his house. That is
brought - Or rather, that shall be brought: for though the people might
vow to bring it thither in convenient time, yet it is not likely they
would bring much money thither in the tyrannical and idolatrous reign of
Athaliah. The money - The half shekel, which was paid for every one that
was numbered from twenty years old and upward. Is set at - Hebrew. the
money of souls, or persons according to his taxing, the money which
every man that had vowed his person to God, paid according to the rate
which the priest put upon him. That cometh - All that shall be freely
offered.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiii.ii-p3">15. Faithfully - For they perceived by many experiments
that they were faithful.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiii.ii-p4">20. And slew Joash - We are told, in the Chronicles, that
his murdering the prophet, Jehoiada's son, was the provocation. In this,
how unrighteous so ever they were, yet the Lord was righteous. And this
was not the only time, that he let even kings know, it was at their
peril, if they touched his anointed, or did his prophets any harm. Thus
fell Joash, who began in the spirit, and ended in the flesh. And indeed
God usually sets marks of his displeasure upon apostates, even in this
life.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="66.78%" prev="ii.xiii.xiii.ii" next="ii.xiii.xiv.i" id="ii.xiii.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XIII" id="ii.xiii.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="66.78%" prev="ii.xiii.xiv" next="ii.xiii.xiv.ii" id="ii.xiii.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.i-p1">The reign of Jehoahaz, ver. 1-9. A general account of the
reign of Joash, ver. 10-13. Elisha falls sick, encourages Joash and
dies, ver. 14-19. A dead body is raised by touching his bones, ver.
20-21. Hazael oppresses Israel, and dies, ver. 22-24. Joash beats the
Syrians, ver. 25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="66.79%" prev="ii.xiii.xiv.i" next="ii.xiii.xv" id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p1">6. The grove - Which Ahab had planted for the worship of
Baal, and which should have been destroyed, <scripRef passage="Deut. vii. 5" id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Deut|7|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.7.5">Deut. vii, 5</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p2">7. He - The king of Syria. People - Of his army, or men
of war.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p3">8. His might - For though his success was not good, he
shewed much personal valour. Which is noted to intimate, that the
Israelites were not conquered, because of the cowardice of their king,
but merely from the righteous judgment of God, who was now resolved to
reckon with them for their apostacy.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p4">14. Fallen sick, &amp;c. - He lived long: for it was
sixty years since he was first called to be a prophet. It was a great
mercy to Israel and especially to the sons of the prophets, that he was
continued so long, a burning and a shining light. Elijah finished his
testimony, in a fourth part of that time. God's prophets have their day
set them, longer or shorter, as infinite wisdom sees fit. But all the
latter part of his time, from the anointing of Jehu, which was forty
five years before Joash began his reign, we find no mention of him, or
of any thing he did, 'till we find him here upon his death bed. Yet he
might be useful to the last, tho' not so famous as he had sometimes
been.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p5">17. Eastward - Toward Syria, which lay northeastward,
from the land of Israel: this arrow is shot against the Syrians, as a
token what God intended to do against them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p6">18. Smite - The former sign portended victory, this was
to declare the number of the victories.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p7">20. Moabites invaded - The mentioning this immediately on
the death of Elisha intimates, that the removal of God's faithful
prophets, is a presage of judgments approaching.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p8">21. He revived - Which miracle God wrought, to do honour
to that great prophet, and that by this seal he might confirm his
doctrine, to strengthen the faith of Joash, and of the Israelites, in
this promise of their success against the Syrians; and in the midst of
all their calamities to comfort such Israelites as were Elisha's
followers, with the hopes of eternal life, whereof this was a manifest
pledge, and to awaken the rest of that people to a due care and
preparation for it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xiv.ii-p9">23. Had compassion - The slowness of God's process
against sinners even when they remain impenitent must be construed to
the advantage of his mercy, not the impeachment of his justice.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="66.83%" prev="ii.xiii.xiv.ii" next="ii.xiii.xv.i" id="ii.xiii.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XIV" id="ii.xiii.xv-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="66.83%" prev="ii.xiii.xv" next="ii.xiii.xv.ii" id="ii.xiii.xv.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.i-p1">The good character of Amaziah, ver. 1-4. He avenges his
father's death, ver. 5, 6. Overthrows the Edomites, ver. 7. Is defeated
by Joash, ver. 8-14. The death and burial of Joash, ver. 15, 16. Amaziah
is killed by conspirators, ver. 17-20. The beginning of Azariah's reign,
ver. 21, 22. The reign and death of Jeroboam, ver. 23-29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="66.83%" prev="ii.xiii.xv.i" next="ii.xiii.xvi" id="ii.xiii.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p1">4. High places - It is hard to get clear of those
corruptions, which by long usage have gained prescription.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p2">6. Slew not - Wherein he shewed faith and courage, that
he would obey this command of God, though it was hazardous to himself,
such persons being likely to seek revenge for their father's death.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p3">7. Joktheel - Which signifies, the obedience of God, that
is, given him by God as a reward of his obedience to God's message by
the prophet, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxv. 8, 9" id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p3.1" parsed="|2Chr|25|8|25|9" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.25.8-2Chr.25.9">2 Chron. xxv, 8, 9</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p4">8. Sent - This challenge he sent, from self-confidence,
and a desire of advancing his glory. But he that is fond either of
fighting or going to law, will probably be the first that repents
it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p5">9. Saying, &amp;c. - By the thistle, a low and
contemptible, yet troublesome shrub, he understands Amaziah; and by the
cedar, himself, whom he intimates to be far stronger than he, and out of
his reach. Trod down - And with no less ease shall my soldiers tread
down thee and thy forces.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p6">10. Glory - Content thyself with that glory, and let not
thine ambition betray thee to ruin.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p7">12. Tents - Josephus says, when they were to engage, they
were struck with such a terror, that they did not strike a stroke, but
every man made the best of his way.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p8">13. Ahaziah - Amaziah's pedigree comes in somewhat
abruptly, the son of Joash, the son of Ahaziah: Probably because he now
smarted, for the iniquity of his ancestors.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p9">20. On horses - Or, with horses, in a chariot.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p10">21. Azariah - This Azariah is called Uzziah, chap. xv,
30, both names signifying the same thing for substance; that, God's
help; and this, God's strength. But this was not done till twelve years
after his father's death: so long the government was in the hands of
protectors.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p11">25. The sea - Unto the dead sea, once a goodly plain, <scripRef passage="Gen. xiii. 10" id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Gen|13|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.13.10">Gen. xiii,
10</scripRef>, which was their southern border.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p12">26. Was bitter - Whereby he was moved to pity and help
them, though they were an unworthy people. Nor any left - Both towns and
country were utterly laid waste.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p13">27. Said not - Not yet; he had not yet declared this, as
afterwards he did by the succeeding prophets.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xv.ii-p14">29. Jeroboam - It was in the reign of this Jeroboam, that
Hosea began to prophesy, and he was the first that wrote his prophecies.
At the same time Amos prophesied, soon after Micah, and then Isaiah in
the days of Ahaz and Hezekiah. Thus God never left himself without
witness, but in the darkest ages of the church, raised up some to be
burning and shining lights, to their own age, by their preaching and
living; and a few by their writings to reflect light upon us, on whom
the ends of the world are come.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="66.88%" prev="ii.xiii.xv.ii" next="ii.xiii.xvi.i" id="ii.xiii.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XV" id="ii.xiii.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="66.88%" prev="ii.xiii.xvi" next="ii.xiii.xvi.ii" id="ii.xiii.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xvi.i-p1">The reign of Azariah, ver. 1-7. Of Zachariah, ver. 8-12.
Of Shallum, ver. 13-15. Of Menahem, ver. 16-22. Of Pekahiah, ver. 23-26.
Of Pekah, ver. 27-31. Of Jotham, ver. 32-38.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="66.88%" prev="ii.xiii.xvi.i" next="ii.xiii.xvii" id="ii.xiii.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xvi.ii-p1">1. To reign - Solely and fully to exercise his regal
power.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvi.ii-p2">5. A leper - The cause whereof see <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxvi. 16" id="ii.xiii.xvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Chr|26|16|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.26.16">2 Chron. xxvi, 16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvi.ii-p3">8. Six months - After the throne had been vacant several
years, thro' the dissentions that were in the kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvi.ii-p4">13. Full moon - That dominion seldom lasts long, which is
founded in blood and falsehood.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvi.ii-p5">30. Twentieth year - The meaning is, that he began his
reign in the twentieth year after the beginning of Jotham's reign; or,
which is the same thing, in the fourth year of Ahaz, son of Jotham.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvi.ii-p6">33. To reign - Alone: for he had reigned before this, as
his father's deputy.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvi.ii-p7">35. Gate - Not of the temple, but of one of the courts of
the temple, probably that which led to the king's palace.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="66.90%" prev="ii.xiii.xvi.ii" next="ii.xiii.xvii.i" id="ii.xiii.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XVI" id="ii.xiii.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="66.90%" prev="ii.xiii.xvii" next="ii.xiii.xvii.ii" id="ii.xiii.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xvii.i-p1">The idolatry of Ahaz, ver. 1-4. He hires the king of
Assyria to invade Syria and Israel, ver. 5-9. He erects a new altar in
the temple, ver. 10-16. Spoils the temple, ver. 17-18. Dies, ver. 19,
20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="66.90%" prev="ii.xiii.xvii.i" next="ii.xiii.xviii" id="ii.xiii.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xvii.ii-p1">3. Pass - By way of oblation, so as to be consumed for a
burnt- offering, which was the practice of Heathens, and of some
Israelites, in imitation of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvii.ii-p2">5. Could not overcome - Because God of his own mere
grace, undertook his protection, and disappointed the hopes of his
enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvii.ii-p3">7. Sent messengers, &amp;c. - But was it because there
was no God in Israel, that he sent to the Assyrian for help? The sin
itself was its own punishment; for tho' it served his present turn, yet
he made but an ill bargain, seeing he not only impoverished himself, but
enslaved both himself and his people.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvii.ii-p4">12. Offered - A sacrifice, and that not to God, but to
the Syrian idols, to whom that altar was appropriated.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvii.ii-p5">13. Peace-offerings - For the Heathens; and Ahaz, in
imitation of them, offered the same sorts of offerings to their false
gods, which the Israelites did to the true.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvii.ii-p6">14. Brazen altar - Of burnt-offerings, made by Solomon,
and placed there by God's appointment. From between, &amp;c. - His new
altar was at first set below the brazen altar, and at a farther distance
from the temple. This he took for a disparagement to his altar; and
therefore impiously takes that away, and puts his in its place. And put,
&amp;c. - So he put God's altar out of its place and use! A bolder
stroke than the very worst of kings had hitherto given to religion.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvii.ii-p7">15. Great altar - This new altar; which was greater than
Solomon's. Sacrifice - Whatsoever is offered to the true God, either in
my name (for possibly he did not yet utterly forsake God, but worshipped
idols with him) or on the behalf of the people, shall be offered on this
new altar. Inquire by - That shall be reserved for my proper use, to
inquire by; at which I may seek God, or inquire of his will, by
sacrifices joined with prayer, when I shall see fit. Having thrust it
out from the use for which it was instituted, which was to sanctify the
gifts offered upon it, he pretends to advance it above its institution,
which it is common for superstitious people to do. But to overdo is to
underdo. Our wisdom is, to do just what God has commanded.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xvii.ii-p8">18. The covert - The form and use whereof is now unknown.
It is generally understood of some building, either that where the
priests after their weekly course was ended, abode until the next course
came; which was done upon the sabbath-day: or that in which the guard of
the temple kept their station; or that under which the king used to sit
to hear God's word, and see the sacrifices; which is called, the covert
of the sabbath, because the chief times in which the king used it for
those ends, was the weekly sabbath, and other solemn days of feasting,
or fasting (which all come under the name of sabbaths in the Old
Testament) upon which the king used more solemnly, to present himself
before the Lord, than at other times. The entry - By which the king used
to go from his palace to the temple.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="66.95%" prev="ii.xiii.xvii.ii" next="ii.xiii.xviii.i" id="ii.xiii.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XVII" id="ii.xiii.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="66.95%" prev="ii.xiii.xviii" next="ii.xiii.xviii.ii" id="ii.xiii.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.i-p1">The reign of Hoshea, ver. 1, 2. The king of Assyria
imprisons him, and carries Israel captive, ver. 3-6. The cause of this
captivity, ver. 7-23. The strange nations transplanted into Canaan are
plagued with lions, ver. 24-26. An Israelitish priest is sent to them,
ver. 27-28. The mongrel religion which followed, ver. 29-41.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="66.96%" prev="ii.xiii.xviii.i" next="ii.xiii.xix" id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p1">1. To reign - He usurped the kingdom in Ahaz's fourth
year; but either was not owned as king, by the generality of the people;
or was not accepted and established in his kingdom, 'till Ahaz's twelfth
year. Nine - After his confirmation and peaceable possession of his
kingdom: for in all, he reigned seventeen, or eighteen years; twelve
with Ahaz, who reigned sixteen years, and six with Hezekiah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p2">2. But not, &amp;c. - For he neither worshipped Baal, as
many of his predecessors did; nor compelled the people to worship the
calves; (one of them, that of Daniel, being destroyed, or carried away
before, as the Hebrew writers affirm;) nor, as some add, hindered those
by force, who were minded to go to Jerusalem to worship. And yet, the
measure of the Israelites sins, being now full, vengeance comes upon
them without remedy.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p3">3. Shalmaneser - The son, or successor of
Tiglath-pileser. The ancient Hebrew writers made him the same with
Sennacherib, who eight years after this time, invaded the kingdom of
Judah; it being very frequent in the Eastern parts, for one man to be
called by several names. Josephus affirms, that he met with his name in
the annals of the Tyrians, which were extant in his days. He came
against him, either because he denied the tribute which he had promised
to pay; or that he might make him tributary.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p4">6. Carried Israel away, &amp;c. - There, we have reason
to think, after some time, they were so mingled with the nations, that
they were lost, and the name of Israel was no more in remembrance. They
that forgot God, were themselves forgotten, and they that studied to be
like the nations, were buried among them. Thus ended Israel as a nation.
When we read their entry into Canaan, under Hoshea the son of Nun, who
would have thought, that such would be their exit, under Hoshea, the son
of Elah? Yet we find St. James writing to the twelve tribes scattered
abroad. So that tho' we never read of the return of those that were
carried captive, nor have any ground to believe, that they still remain
a distinct body in some remote corner of the world, yet a remnant of
them did escape, and will remain 'till all Israel shall be saved.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p5">9. Did secretly - This belongs, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p6">1. To their gross idolatries, and other
abominable practices, which they were ashamed to own before others;
or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p7">2. to the worship of calves: and so the
words are otherwise rendered; they covered things that were not right
towards the Lord: they covered their idolatrous worship of the calves,
with fair pretenses of necessity, the two kingdoms being now divided,
and at enmity; and of their honest intention of serving the true God,
and retaining the substance of the Jewish religion. City - In all parts
and places, both in cities, and in the country; yea, in the most
uninhabited parts, where few or none dwell, beside the watchmen, who are
left there in towers, to preserve the cattle and fruits of the earth, or
to give notice of the approach of enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p8">13. Seers - To whom he declared his mind, by Revelations
and visions, and by whom he published it, bearing witness, from heaven
to their doctrine by eminent and glorious miracles.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p9">14. Hardened, &amp;c. - Refused to submit their neck to
the yoke of God's precepts. A metaphor from stubborn oxen, that will not
bow to the yoke.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p10">15. Vanity - Idols; so called because of their
nothingness, impotency, and unprofitableness; and by the long worship of
idols, they were made like them, vain, sottish, and senseless
creatures.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p11">16. Left all - They grew worse and worse; from a partial
disobedience to some of God's laws, they fell by degrees to a total
apostacy from all. The host - The stars, as Saturn, Jupiter, Mars,
Venus.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p12">18. Judah only - And the greatest part of the tribe of
Benjamin, with those of the tribes of Simeon and Levi who were
incorporated with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p13">19. Judah kept not - Judah's idolatry and wickedness are
here remembered, as an aggravation of the sin of the Israelites, which
was not only evil in itself, but mischievous to their neighbour, who by
their examples were instructed in their wicked arts, and provoked to an
imitation of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p14">20. All Israel - All the tribes of Israel: first, one
part of them, and now the rest. But this extends not to every individual
person of these tribes; for many of them removed into the kingdom of
Judah, and were associated with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p15">21. They made - Which action is here ascribed to the
people, because they would not tarry 'till God by his providence, had
invested Jeroboam with the kingdom which he had promised him; but
rashly, and rebelliously, rose up against the house of David, to which
they had so great obligations; and set him upon the throne without God's
leave or advice. Drave - He not only dissuaded, but kept then, by force
from God's worship at Jerusalem, the only place appointed for it. A
great sin - So the worship of the calves is called, to meet with that
idle conceit of the Israelites, who esteemed it a small sin, especially
when they were forced to it by severe penalties; which yet he shews did
not excuse it from being a sin, and a great sin too.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p16">25. Therefore - For their gross neglect, and contempt of
God, which was contrary to the principles and practices of the Heathens,
who used to worship the gods of the nations where they lived, and gave
that honour to their false Gods, which here they denied to the true.
Hereby also God asserted his own sovereignty over that land, and made
them to understand, that neither the Israelites were cast out, nor they
brought in by their valour, or strength, but by God's providence, who as
he had cast the Israelites out for their neglect of God's service; so
both could, and would in his due time, turn them out also, if they were
guilty of the same sins.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p17">28. Taught them - The manner of God's worship, as it was
practiced in Israel; as may be gathered both from the quality of this
person, who was an Israelitish priest; and from the place of his
residence, Beth-el, a place infamous for the worship of the calves, and
from the manner of their making priests by this man's direction.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p18">32. Sacrificed - Unto the true God: for as to the worship
of their own gods, they needed no instruction, and would not permit a
person of another religion to minister therein.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p19">33. They feared - They worshipped God externally in that
way which the Israelites used. But every nation made gods of their own
besides.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p20">34. Unto this day - That is, till the time when this book
was written, above three hundred years in all, till the time of
Alexander the Great, when they were prevailed upon to call away their
idols. Former manners - As the Israelites before their captivity, gave
these nations an ill example, in serving the Lord, and Baal together;
so, or after their former manner, they do unto this day, in the land of
their captivity. They fear not - Though they pretended to fear, and
serve both the Lord and idols, yet in truth they did not, and do not
fear or worship the Lord, but their own calves, or other vain
inventions: and God will not accept that mongrel and false worship,
which they pretend to give to the true God. Statutes - God's law
delivered to their fathers, and to them, as their inheritance, <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p20.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm
1</scripRef>xix, 111. This is alleged as an evidence, that they did not fear the
Lord, whatsoever they pretended, because they lived in the constant
breach of his statutes. Israel - A name, signifying his special interest
in God, and power with him, which was given to him, not only for
himself, but for his posterity also, whom God frequently honours with
that name. And by this great favour he aggravates their sin.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xviii.ii-p21">41. So - In like manner, and after their example. These -
Who came in their stead.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="67.09%" prev="ii.xiii.xviii.ii" next="ii.xiii.xix.i" id="ii.xiii.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XVIII" id="ii.xiii.xix-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="67.09%" prev="ii.xiii.xix" next="ii.xiii.xix.ii" id="ii.xiii.xix.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.i-p1">Hezekiah reforms his kingdom, ver. 1-6. Prospers in all
his undertakings, even at the time the ten tribes are led captive, ver.
7- 12. Yet is invaded, and his country put under contribution by
Sennacherib, ver. 13-16. Jerusalem is besieged, ver. 17. The virulent
speech of Rabshakeh, ver. 18-25. He incites the people to revolt, ver.
26-37.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="67.10%" prev="ii.xiii.xix.i" next="ii.xiii.xx" id="ii.xiii.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p1">2. To reign - It is not certain that Ahaz lived only
thirty six years, for those sixteen years which he reigned, may be
computed, not from the first beginning of his reign, when he reigned
with his father; which was at the twentieth year of his age, but from
the beginning of his reigning alone.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p2">4. Serpent - The most of them, or such as the people most
frequented: for all were not taken away, chap. xxiii, 13, 14, tho' his
own father had set them up. We must never dishonour God, in honour to
our earthly parents. Brazen serpent - Which had been hitherto kept as a
memorial of God's mercy; but being now commonly abused to superstition,
was destroyed. To it - Not doubtless as to a God, but only as to an
instrument of God's mercy, by and through which, their adoration was
directed to God, and given to that only for God's sake. Nehushtan - He
said, this serpent, howsoever formerly honoured, and used by God as a
sign of his grace, yet now it is nothing but a piece of brass which can
do you neither good nor hurt.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p3">5. Trusted - Without calling in foreign succors to
establish or help him; which his father Ahaz did; and before him Asa.
Before him - Of the kings of Judah only; for David and Solomon were
kings of all Israel. The like is said of Josiah, chap. xxiii, 25. Each
of them, excelled the other in several respects. Hezekiah in this, that
he fell upon this work in the beginning of his reign, which Josiah did
not, and with no less resolution, undertaking to do that which none of
his predecessors durst do, even to remove the high places, wherein
Josiah did only follow his example.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p4">7. Rebelled - He shook off that yoke of subjection, to
which his father had wickedly submitted, and reassumed that full and
independent sovereignty which God had settled in the house of David. And
Hezekiah's case differs much from that of Zedekiah, who is blamed for
rebellion against the king of Babylon, both because he had engaged
himself by a solemn oath and covenant, which we do not read of Ahaz; and
because he broke the covenant which he himself had made; and because God
had actually given the dominion of his own land and people to the king
of Babylon, and commanded both Zedekiah and his people to submit to him.
And whereas Hezekiah is here said to rebel; that word implies, only a
defection from that subjection which had been performed to another;
which sometimes may be justly done, and therefore that word doth not
necessarily prove this to be a sin. And that it was not a sin in him,
seems certain, because God owned and assisted him therein; and did not
at all reprove him for it, in that message which he sent to him by
Isaiah, nor afterwards, though he did particularly reprove him, for his
vain-glory, and ostentation, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxii. 25, 26" id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p4.1" parsed="|2Chr|32|25|32|26" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.32.25-2Chr.32.26">2
Chron. xxxii, 25, 26</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p5">13. Them - Many of them; universal particles being
frequently so used both in scripture, and other authors; and this
success God gave him; to lift him up to his own greater and more
shameful destruction: to humble and chastise his own people for their
manifold sins, and, to gain an eminent opportunity to advance his own
honour by that miraculous deliverance which he designed for his
people.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p6">14. Three hundred talents, &amp;c. - Above two hundred
thousand pounds.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p7">17. Sent - Having received the money, upon which he
agreed to depart from Hezekiah and his land, he breaks his faith with
Hezekiah, thereby justifying his revolt, and preparing the way for his
own destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p8">19. Thus saith, &amp;c. - But what are the greatest men
when they come to compare with God, or when God comes to contend with
them?</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p9">21. This broken reed - Whoever trusts in man, leans on a
broken reed: but God is the rock of ages.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p10">22. Is not, &amp;c. - Thus boldly he speaks of the things
which he understood not, judging of the great God, by their petty gods;
and of God's worship by the vain fancies of the Heathens, who measured
piety by the multitude of altars.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p11">25. Am I, &amp;c. - He neither owned God's word, nor
regarded his providence; but he forged this, to strike a terror into
Hezekiah and the people.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p12">27. To the men - To tell them to what extremities and
miseries he will force them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p13">28. Jews language - The tradition of the Jews is, that
Rabshaketh was an apostate Jew. If so, his ignorance of the God of
Israel was the less excusable, and his enmity the less strange: for
apostates are usually the most bitter and spiteful enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xix.ii-p14">31. A present - Upon which terms, I will give you no
disturbance; but quietly suffer each of you to enjoy his own
possession.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="67.18%" prev="ii.xiii.xix.ii" next="ii.xiii.xx.i" id="ii.xiii.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XIX" id="ii.xiii.xx-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="67.18%" prev="ii.xiii.xx" next="ii.xiii.xx.ii" id="ii.xiii.xx.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.i-p1">Hezekiah sends to Isaiah to desire his prayers, ver. 1-5.
And receives from him an answer of peace, ver. 6, 7. Sennacherib sends a
threatening letter to Hezekiah, ver. 8-13 Who recommends his case to
God, ver. 14-19. God by Isaiah sends him a comfortable message, ver.
20-34. The army of the Assyrians is destroyed, ver. 35-37</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="67.18%" prev="ii.xiii.xx.i" next="ii.xiii.xxi" id="ii.xiii.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p1">1. Rent his cloaths, &amp;c. - Great men must not think
it any disparagement to them, to sympathize with the injured honour of
the great God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p2">3. The children - We are like a poor travailing woman in
great extremity, having no strength left to help herself, and to bring
forth her infant into the world. We have attempted to deliver ourselves
from the Assyrian yoke; and had carried on that work to some maturity,
and as we thought, brought it to the birth; but now we have no might to
finish. We have begun an happy reformation, and are hindered by this
insolent Assyrian, from bringing it to perfection.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p3">4. For the remnant - For Judah, which is but a remnant,
now the ten tribes are gone: for Jerusalem, which is but a remnant, now
the defensed cities of Judah are taken.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p4">8. Returned - To the king, to give him an account of the
treaty; leaving behind him the army under the other commanders.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p5">15. O Lord God of Israel, &amp;c. - He calls him the God
of Israel, because Israel was his peculiar people; but yet the God of
the whole earth, not as Sennacherib fancied, the God of Israel only. Let
them say what they will, thou art sovereign Lord, the God of gods, even
thou alone: Universal Lord of all the kingdoms of the earth; and
rightful Lord; for thou hast made heaven and earth. Being creator of
all, by an incontestable title thou art owner and ruler of all.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p6">16. Him - Rabshakeh: he would not do him the honour to
name him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p7">21. Virgin - So he calls Zion, or Jerusalem; because she
was pure in good measure from that gross idolatry wherewith other people
were defiled, which is called spiritual whoredom: and to signify, that
God would defend her from the rape which Sennacherib intended to commit
upon her with no less care than parents do their virgin daughters from
those who seek to force and deflower them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p8">23. Mountains - I have brought up my very chariots to
those mountains which were thought inaccessible by my army. Lebanon - An
high hill, famous for cedars and fir-trees. Cut down - I will cut down
the trees that hinder my march, and plane the way for my numerous army
and chariots. Lodgings - Those cities (which he calls lodgings in way of
contempt) which are in his utmost borders. I am come into the land of
Canaan at one border, Lebanon, and I resolve to march on to the other
border, and so destroy the whole country, from one border to the other.
Carmel - The forest of mount Carmel, which may seem to be another
inaccessible place, like Lebanon.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p9">24. Strange waters - Such as were never discovered by
others. Dried up - And as I can furnish my army with water digged out of
the earth; so I can deprive my enemies of their water, and can dry up
their rivers, and that with the sole of my feet; with the march of my
vast and numerous army, who will easily do this, either by marching
through them, and each carrying away part with them: or by making new
channels, and driving the waters of the river into them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p10">25. Hast thou not, &amp;c. - Hast thou not long since
learned, that which some of thy philosophers could teach thee; that
there is a supreme and powerful God, by whose decree and providence all
these wars and calamities were sent, and ordered; whose mere instrument
thou art, so that thou hast no cause for these vain boastings? This work
is mine, not thine. I have, &amp;c. - I have so disposed of things by my
providence, that thou shouldest be a great and victorious prince, and
that thou shouldest be so successful as thou hast hitherto been, first
against the kingdom of Israel, and now against Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p11">26. Therefore - Because I had armed thee with my
commission and strength, and taken away their spirit and courage.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p12">27. I know - Though thou dost not know me, yet I
throughly know thee, and all thy designs and actions, all thy secret
contrivances in the place of thy abode, in thy own kingdom and court;
and the execution of thy designs abroad, what thou intendest in thy
going out, and with what farther thoughts thou comest in, or returnest
to thy own land.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p13">28. My hook, &amp;c. - What a comfort is it, that God has
a hook in the nose and a bridle in the jaws of all his and our
enemies?</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p14">29. A sign - Of the certain accomplishment of the
promises here made: that God will not only preserve the city from his
present fury, but also, bless his people with a durable prosperity, ver.
30, 31. The third year - This was an excellent sign; especially,
considering the waste and havock which the Assyrians had made in the
land; and that the Jews had been forced to retire into their strong
hold, and consequently to neglect their tilling, and sowing, and
reaping; and yet this year they should have sufficient provision from
those fruits of the earth which the Assyrians left; and the second year,
which was the year of release, in which they might neither sow, nor
reap, from such fruits as the earth brought forth of its own accord; and
so in the third year. And eat - You shall not sow, and another reap, as
lately you did; but you shall enjoy the fruit of your own labours.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p15">30. The remnant, &amp;c. - They shall be well fixt and
provided for themselves, and then do good to others.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p16">31. Go forth - That handful of Jews who were now gathered
together, and shut up in Jerusalem, shall go out of their several
habitations, and by my singular blessing increase exceedingly. The zeal
- Although when you reflect upon yourselves, and consider either your
present fewness, and weakness, or your great unworthiness, this may seem
too great a blessing for you to expect; yet God will do it from the zeal
which he hath, both for his own name, and for the good of his
undeserving people.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p17">32. He shall not - The army sent with Rabshaketh did not
form a close siege against it, but only disposed themselves so as to
block it up at some distance; possibly waiting 'till the king of Assyria
had taken Libnah and Lachish, (which they presumed he would speedily
do.)</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p18">35. Angel - Such an angel as destroyed the first-born of
Egypt. Arose - The few that were left alive: all their companions were
dead.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p19">36. So Sennacherib, &amp;c. - The manner of the
expression intimates the great disorder and distraction of mind he was
in.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xx.ii-p20">37. Was worshipping, &amp;c. - The God of Israel had done
enough to convince him, that he was the only true God. Yet he persists
in his idolatry. Justly then is his blood mingled with his sacrifices,
who will not be convinced by so dear-bought a demonstration, of his
folly in worshipping idols.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="67.30%" prev="ii.xiii.xx.ii" next="ii.xiii.xxi.i" id="ii.xiii.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XX" id="ii.xiii.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="67.30%" prev="ii.xiii.xxi" next="ii.xiii.xxi.ii" id="ii.xiii.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.i-p1">Hezekiah's sickness and recovery, ver. 1-7. The sign
given him, ver. 8-11. He shews the Babylonians all his treasures, ver.
12-13. The Babylonish captivity foretold, ver. 14-19. He dies, ver. 20,
21</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="67.30%" prev="ii.xiii.xxi.i" next="ii.xiii.xxii" id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p1">1. Those days - In the year of the Assyrian invasion.
Set, &amp;c. - Make thy will, and settle the affairs of thy family and
kingdom. Not live - Such threatenings, though absolutely expressed, have
often secret conditions.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p2">2. Turned his face - As he lay in his bed. He could not
retire to his closet, but he retired as well as he could, turned from
the company, to converse with God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p3">3. In truth - Sincerely with an honest mind. I am not
conscious to myself of any gross exorbitances, for which thou usest to
shorten mens days. Wept - For that horror of death which is and was
common to men, especially, in the times of the Old Testament, when the
grace of God in Christ was not so fully manifested, as now it is: and,
for the distracted condition in which the church and state were then
likely to be left, through the uncertainty of the succession to the
crown.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p4">4. Court - Of the king's palace. This is noted to shew
God's great readiness to hear the prayers of his children.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p5">5. God of, &amp;c. - I am mindful of my promise made to
David and his house, and will make it good in thy person. Shalt go - To
give me solemn praise for this mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p6">6. Fifteen years - We have not an instance of any other,
who was told before-hand just how long, he should live. God has wisely
kept us at uncertainties, that we may be always ready.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p7">10. Go down - In an instant: for that motion of the sun
is natural for the kind of it, though miraculous for the swiftness of
it; but the other would be both ways miraculous.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p8">11. Degrees - These degrees were lines in the dial: but
whether each of these lines or degrees noted an hour, or half an hour,
or a quarter of an hour, is uncertain. But the sun itself went back, and
the shadow with it. This miracle was noted by the Babylonians, who,
having understood that it was done for Hezekiah's sake, sent to inquire
into the truth and manner of it, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxii. 31" id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p8.1" parsed="|2Chr|32|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.32.31">2 Chron. xxxii, 31</scripRef>. Of Ahaz - Which Ahaz had made in the king's palace. This
dial he mentions, because the truth of the miracle might be best and
soonest discovered there, this dial possibly being visible out of the
king's chamber, and the degrees being most distinct and conspicuous in
it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p9">12. Berodach-baladan - He seems to have been the king of
Assyria's vice-roy in Babylon, and upon that terrible slaughter in the
Assyrian host, and the death of Sennacherib, and the differences among
his sons, to have usurped absolute sovereignty over Babylon. And either
himself or his son destroyed the Assyrian monarchy, and translated the
empire to Babylon. Sent - Partly, for the reasons mentioned, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxii. 31" id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p9.1" parsed="|2Chr|32|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.32.31">2 Chron. xxxii, 31</scripRef>, and partly, to assure himself of the assistance of Hezekiah
against the Assyrians, their common enemy.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p10">13. His treasures - For though his country had lately
been harassed by the Assyrians, yet he had reserved all his treasures
and precious things, which he and his fathers had gathered in Jerusalem.
Besides, he had considerable spoils out of the Assyrian camp. Also he
had many presents sent to him, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxii. 23" id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|2Chr|32|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.32.23">2 Chron. xxxii, 23</scripRef>. Shewed - Which he did through pride of heart, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxii. 25, 26" id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p10.2" parsed="|2Chr|32|25|32|26" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.32.25-2Chr.32.26">2 Chron. xxxii, 25,
26</scripRef>, being lifted up by the great honour which God had done him,
in working such glorious miracles for his sake, and by the great
respects rendered to him from divers princes, and now by this great
Babylonian monarch. So hard a matter is it even for a good man to be
high and humble.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p11">17. Behold - This judgment is denounced against him for
his pride; for his ingratitude, whereby he took that honour to himself
which he should have given entirely to God; and for his carnal
confidence in that league which he had now made with the king of
Babylon, by which, it is probable, he thought his mountain to be so
strong, that it could not be removed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p12">18. Thy sons - Of thy grand-children. Eunuchs - They
shall be servants to that heathen monarch, whereby both their bodies
will be subject to slavery, and their souls exposed to the peril of
idolatry, and all sorts of wickedness.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxi.ii-p13">19. Good is, &amp;c. - I heartily submit to this
sentence, as being both just, and merciful. True penitents, when they
are under divine rebukes, call them not only just, but good. Not only
submit to, but accept of the punishment of their iniquity. So Hezekiah
did, and by this it appeared, he was indeed humbled for the pride of his
heart.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="67.38%" prev="ii.xiii.xxi.ii" next="ii.xiii.xxii.i" id="ii.xiii.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XXI" id="ii.xiii.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="67.38%" prev="ii.xiii.xxii" next="ii.xiii.xxii.ii" id="ii.xiii.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.i-p1">The wicked reign of Manasseh, ver. 1-9. Judgment
denounced against him and Jerusalem, ver. 10-16. His death, ver. 17, 18.
The wicked reign of Amon, ver. 19-22. He is slain, and succeeded by
Josiah, ver. 23-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="67.38%" prev="ii.xiii.xxii.i" next="ii.xiii.xxiii" id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p1">1. Reigned - In which time the years of his imprisonment
are comprehended.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p2">3. He built, &amp;c. - Trampling on the dust and
affronting the memory of his worthy father. All the host of heaven - The
sun, moon and stars.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p3">6. Through the fire - Between two fires, by which he
dedicated him to Molock, in contempt of the seal of circumcision by
which he had been dedicated to God. Times - Lucky, or unlucky days
according to the superstitious practice of the heathens.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p4">7. An image - The image of that Baal which was worshipped
in the grove.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p5">9. More evil - Partly, because they were not contented
with those idols which the Canaanites worshipped, but either invented,
or borrowed from other nations many new idols, and partly, because as
their light was far more clear, their obligations to God infinitely
higher, and their helps against idolatry much stronger than the
Canaanites had; so their sins, though the same in kind, were unspeakably
worse in respect of these dreadful aggravations.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p6">13. The line - She shall have the same measure, the same
judgments which Samaria had. The line is often put for one's lot or
portion, because mens portions or possessions used to be measured by
lines. A dish - As men do with a dish that hath been used, first wholly
empty it of all that is in it, then throughly cleanse and wipe it; and
lastly, turn it upside down, that nothing may remain in it; so will I
deal with Jerusalem, throughly empty and purge it from all its wicked
inhabitants. Yet the comparison intimates, that this should be in order
to the purifying, not the final destruction of Jerusalem. The dish shall
not be broken in pieces, or wholly cast away, but only wiped.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p7">15. Since, &amp;c. - This forejudgment, though it was
chiefly inflicted for the sins of Manasseh and his generation, yet had a
respect unto all their former sins.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p8">16. Blood - The blood of those prophets and righteous men
who either reproved his sinful practices, or refused to comply with his
wicked commands. His sin - His idolatry, which is called sin, by way of
eminency. The tradition of the Jews is, that he caused Isaiah in
particular to be sawn asunder.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p9">18. Garden - Not in the sepulchre of the kings; probably,
by his own choice and command, as a lasting testimony of his sincere
repentance and abhorrence of himself for his former crime.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxii.ii-p10">21. He walked, &amp;c. - He revived that idolatry which
Manasseh in the latter end of his reign had put down. Those who set bad
examples, if they repent themselves, cannot be sure that they whom their
example has drawn into sin will repent. It is often otherwise.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="67.43%" prev="ii.xiii.xxii.ii" next="ii.xiii.xxiii.i" id="ii.xiii.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XXII" id="ii.xiii.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="67.43%" prev="ii.xiii.xxiii" next="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii" id="ii.xiii.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.i-p1">The general character of Josiah, ver. 1, 2. He repairs
the temple, ver. 3-7. The high-priest brings him the original book of
the law, ver. 8-10. He sends to consult Huldah the prophetess, ver.
11-14. The destruction of Jerusalem foretold, ver. 15-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXII" progress="67.43%" prev="ii.xiii.xxiii.i" next="ii.xiii.xxiv" id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p1">3. The scribe - The secretary of state.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p2">8. The book - That original book of the law of the Lord,
given or written by the hand of Moses, as it is expressed, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxiv. 14" id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Chr|34|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.34.14">2 Chron. xxxiv,
14</scripRef>, which by God's command was put beside the ark, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxxi. 26" id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Deut|31|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.31.26">Deut. xxxi,
26</scripRef>, and probably taken from thence and hid, by the care of some
godly priest, when some of the idolatrous kings of Judah persecuted the
true religion, and defaced the temple, and (which the Jewish writers
affirm) burnt all the copies of God's law which they could find. It was
now found among the rubbish, or in some secret place.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p3">11. The words - The dreadful comminations against them
for the sins still reigning among the people. If Josiah had seen and
read it before, which seems more probable, yet the great reverence which
he justly bare to the original book, and the strange, and remarkable,
and seasonable finding of it, had awakened and quickened him to a more
serious and diligent consideration of all the passages contained in it.
And what a providence was this, that it was still preserved! Yea, what a
providence, that the whole book of God is preserved to us. If the holy
scriptures had not been of God, they had not been in being at this day.
God's care of the bible, is a plain proof of his interest in it. It was
a great instance of God's favour, that the book of the law was thus
seasonably brought to light, to direct and quicken that blessed
reformation, which Joash had begun. And it is observable, they were
about a good work, repairing the temple, when it was found. They that do
their duty according to their knowledge, shall have their knowledge
increased.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p4">13. Inquire - What we shall do to appease his wrath, and
whether the curses here threatened must come upon us without remedy, or
whether there be hope in Israel concerning the prevention of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p5">14. Huldah - The king's earnest affection required great
haste; and she was in Jerusalem, which is therefore noted in the
following part of the verse, when Jeremiah might at this time be at
Anathoth, or in some more remote part of the kingdom; and the like may
be said of Zephaniah, who also might not be a prophet at this time,
though he was afterward, in the days of Josiah. College - Where the sons
of the prophets, or others, who devoted themselves to the study of God's
word, used to meet and discourse of the things of God, and receive the
instructions of their teachers.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p6">15. The man - She uses no compliments. Tell the man that
sent you - Even kings, though gods to us, are men to God, and shall be
so dealt with: for with him there is no respect of persons.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p7">17. The works - Gods made with hands.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p8">19. Tender - He trembled at God's word. He was grieved
for the dishonour done to God by the sins of his people. He was afraid
of the judgments of God, which he saw coming on Jerusalem. This is
tenderness of heart.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii-p9">20. In peace - That is, in a time of public peace: for
otherwise he died in battle. Besides, he died in peace with God, and was
by death translated to everlasting peace.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="67.48%" prev="ii.xiii.xxiii.ii" next="ii.xiii.xxiv.i" id="ii.xiii.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XXIII" id="ii.xiii.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xxiv-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="67.48%" prev="ii.xiii.xxiv" next="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.i-p1">Josiah reads the law to all the people, ver. 1, 2. Renews
the covenant between God and them, ver. 3. Cleanses the temple, ver. 4.
Roots out idolatry, ver. 5-20. Keeps a solemn passover, ver. 21- 23.
Clears the land of witches, ver. 24. A general commendation of him, ver.
25. His untimely death, ver. 26-30. The reigns of Jehoahaz and
Jehoiakim, ver. 31-37.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="67.49%" prev="ii.xiii.xxiv.i" next="ii.xiii.xxv" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p1">2. Prophets - Either Jeremiah, Zephaniah, Urijah: or, the
sons of the prophets. It seems he read it himself. Josiah did not think
it beneath him, to be a reader, any more than Solomon did to be a
preacher, and David to be even a door keeper in the house of God. All
people are concerned to know the scripture, and all in authority, to
spread the knowledge of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p2">3. Stood - They declared their consent to it, and their
concurrence with the king in that act, which possibly they did by
standing up, as the king himself stood when he took it. It is of good
use, with all possible solemnity, to oblige ourselves to our duty. And
he that bears an honest heart, does not startle at assurances.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p3">4. Second order - Either those two who were next in
degree to the high-priest, and in case of sickness were to manage his
work: or the heads of the twenty four courses which David had appointed.
The grove - The image of the grove: it being most frequent to call
images by the names of the persons or things which they represent. The
fields - Adjoining to the brook of Kidron. To Beth- el - To shew his
abhorrence of them, and that he would not give the ashes of them a place
in his kingdom: and to pollute and disgrace that place which had been
the chief seat and throne of idolatry.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p4">5. Priests - Hebrew. the Chemarim; the highest rank of
priests, employed in the highest work, which was to burn incense.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p5">6. The people - Of that people, those idolatrous people,
as it is explained, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxiv. 4" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p5.1" parsed="|2Chr|34|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.34.4">2 Chron. xxxiv, 4</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p6">7. Sodomites - Sodomy was a part of idol-worship, being
done to the honour of some of their idols, and by the appointment of
those impure and diabolical spirits, which were worshipped in their
idols. Hangings - Or, curtains, either to draw before the idols which
were worshipped in the grove, to preserve them from defilement, or to
gain more reverence for them: Or, garments for the service of the grove,
for the idols or the priests belonging to them. Hebrew. houses, that is,
either little chappels made of woven work, like those which were made of
silver, <scripRef passage="Acts xix. 24" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Acts|19|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Acts.19.24">Acts xix, 24</scripRef>, within which there were some representations of their
grove-idols: or rather, tents made of those curtains for the use above-
mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p7">8. Priests - Belonging to the high-places following,
whether such as worshipped idols; or such as worshipped God in those
forbidden places. Defiled - By burning dead mens bones upon them, or by
putting them to some other unclean use. From Geba - The northern border
of the kingdom of Judah. Beer-sheba - The southern border, from one end
to the other. Gates - Which were erected by the gates of the city here
mentioned, to the honour of their tutelary gods, whom after the manner
of the heathen they owned for the protectors of their city and
habitations. The governor - This circumstance is noted to shew Josiah's
great zeal and impartiality, in rooting out all monuments of idolatry,
without any respects unto those great persons who were concerned in
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p8">9. The priest - Who worshipped the true God there. In
Jerusalem - Were not suffered to come thither to the exercise of their
priestly function; as a just punishment for the corruption of God's
worship, and the transgression of so plain and positive a law of God, <scripRef passage="Deut. xii. 11" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Deut|12|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.12.11">Deut. xii, 11</scripRef>, which was much worse in them who had more knowledge to
discern the will of God, and more obligations to observe it. Did eat -
Of the meal-offerings, allotted to the priests, wherein there was to be
no leaven, <scripRef passage="Lev. ii. 4, 5, 10, 11" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p8.2" parsed="|Lev|2|4|2|5;|Lev|2|10|0|0;|Lev|2|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.2.4-Lev.2.5 Bible:Lev.2.10 Bible:Lev.2.11">Lev. ii, 4, 5, 10, 11</scripRef>, and consequently of other provisions belonging to the
priests, which are contained under this one kind. Thus their spiritual
blemish puts them into the very same state which corporal blemishes
brought them, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxi. 17" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p8.3" parsed="|Lev|21|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.21.17">Lev. xxi, 17</scripRef>, &amp;c. And thus he mitigates their punishment: he shuts
them out from spiritual services, but allows them necessary
provisions.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p9">10. Topheth - Very near Jerusalem, where was the image of
Molech, to whom some sacrificed their children, burning them in the
fire, others dedicated them, making them pass between two fires. It is
supposed to be called Topheth, from toph, a drum; because they beat
drums at the burning of the children, that their shrieks might not be
heard.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p10">11. Horses - Such the eastern nations used to consecrate
to the sun, to signify the swiftness of his motion. The sun - Either, to
be sacrificed to the sun: or, to draw those chariots in which the kings,
or some other in their stead, went forth every morning to worship the
rising sun: for both these were the customs of the Armenians and
Persians, as Xenophon testifies. Entering in - By the gate of the
outward court of the temple. Chamberlain - Or, officer, to whom the care
of these horses were committed. Suburbs - Of the temple: in certain
outward buildings belonging to the temple. Chariots - Which were made
for the worship of the sun.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p11">12. The top - Upon the roof of the king's house. They
were so mad upon their idols, that they were not content with all their
publick high places and altars, but made others upon their house-tops,
for the worship of the heavenly bodies. Cast - To shew his detestation
of them: and to abolish the very remembrance of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p12">13. Corruption - The mount of olives, called the mount of
corruption, for the gross idolatry there practiced. Which - Not the same
individual altars; which doubtless either Solomon upon his repentance,
or some other of Josiah's predecessors had taken away, but other altars
built by Manasseh or Amon, which because erected by Solomon's example,
and for the same use, and in the same place, are called by his name:
this brand is left by the Holy Ghost upon his name and memory, as a just
punishment of that abominable practice, and a mean to deter others from
the like. Abomination - The idol, so called, because it was abominable,
and made them abominable to God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p13">14. Men - Of the idolatrous priests, which he caused to
be taken out of their graves, ver. 18. As he carried the ashes of the
images to the graves, to mingle them with dead mens bones, so he carried
dead mens bones to the places where the images had been, that both ways
idolatry might be rendered loathsome. Dead men and dead gods were indeed
much alike, and fittest to go together.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p14">15. Beth-el - Probably this city was now under the
kingdom of Judah, to which it was added by Abijah long since. And it is
probable, since the ten tribes were carried away, many cities had put
themselves under the protection of Judah. The golden calf, it seems, was
gone; but Josiah would leave no remains of that idolatry.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p15">16. Himself - Josiah's care and zeal was so great, that
he would not trust his officers with these things, but would see them
done with his own eyes. These words - Three hundred years before it was
done.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p16">20. The priests - By this relation it appears, that after
the departure of the king of Assyria, divers of the Israelites who had
retired to other parts, and kept themselves out of the conqueror's
hands, returned together with their priests to their own land, and to
their old trade, worshipping idols; to whom, peradventure, they ascribed
this their deliverance from that judgment which Jehovah had brought upon
them. And burnt - According to that famous prophecy, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xiii. 1, 2" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p16.1" parsed="|1Kgs|13|1|13|2" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.13.1-1Kgs.13.2">1 Kings xiii, 1, 2</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p17">22. Such a passover - Celebrated with such solemn care,
and great preparation, and numerous sacrifices, and universal joy of all
good men; which was much the greater, because of their remembrance of
the former wicked and miserable times under Manasseh, and Amon; and the
good hopes they now had of the happy establishment of their nation, and
the true religion; and of the prevention of God's judgments denounced
against them. Judges - Or, from the days of Samuel, the last of the
Judges; as it is expressed <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxv. 18" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p17.1" parsed="|2Chr|35|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.35.18">2 Chron. xxxv, 18</scripRef>. None of the kings had taken such care to prepare
themselves, the priests, and people, and accurately to observe all the
rites, and diligently to purge out all uncleanness, and to renew their
covenant with God. And undoubtedly God was pleased to recompense their
zeal in destroying idolatry with uncommon tokens of his presence and
favour. All this concurred to make it such a passover as had not been,
even in the days of Hezekiah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p18">24. Images, &amp;c. - Three words noting the same thing,
to shew, That all the instruments and monuments of idolatry were
destroyed, as God had commanded. Spied - All that were discovered; not
only such as were in the place of worship, but such as their priests or
zealots had removed, and endeavoured to hide.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p19">25. No king - For his diligent study in God's law, and
his exact care, and unwearied industry, and fervent zeal, in rooting out
idolators, and all kinds and appearances of idolatry, not only in Judah,
but in Israel also; and in the establishment of the true religion in all
his dominions, and in the conforming of his own life, and his peoples
too, (as far as he could) to the holy law of God: though Hezekiah might
excel him in some particulars.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p20">26. Notwithstanding - Because though the king was most
hearty in his repentance and acceptable to God, and therefore the
judgment was delayed for his time; yet the people were in general
corrupt, and secretly averse from Josiah's pious reformation, as appears
from the complaints of the prophets, especially Jeremiah and Zephaniah,
against them: and by the following history, wherein we see, that as soon
as ever Josiah was gone, his children, and the princes, and the people,
suddenly and greedily returned to their former abominations. Because -
The sins of Manasseh, and for the men of his generation; who concurred
with him in his idolatrous and cruel practices, are justly punished in
this generation: because of God's sovereign right of punishing sinners
when he sees fit: because of that publick declaration of God, that he
would visit the iniquity of the fathers upon the children: and
principally, because these men had never sincerely repented of their
own, nor of their fathers sins.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p21">27. I said - Upon the conditions in sundry places
expressed, which they broke, and therefore God justly made them to know
his breach of promise.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p22">29. The king, &amp;c. - The king of Babylon, who having
formerly rebelled against the Assyrian had now conquered him; as appears
by the course of the sacred, and the concurrence of the prophane
history; and therefore is here and elsewhere called the Assyrian, and
the king of Assyria, because now he was the head of that empire.
Euphrates - Against Carchemish by Euphrates, as it is expressed, <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxv. 20" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p22.1" parsed="|2Chr|35|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.35.20">2 Chron. xxxv, 20</scripRef>, which the Assyrian had taken from Pharaoh's confederates,
who therefore sends forces against the Assyrian, that he might both help
them, and secure himself. Josiah went - Either to defend his own country
from Pharaoh's incursions; or to assist the king of Babylon, with whom
he seems to have been in league. Slew - Gave him his death wound there;
though he died not 'till he came to Jerusalem. Seen him - When he fought
with him, or in the first onset. It does not appear, that Josiah had any
clear call to engage in this war; possibly he received his death wound,
as a punishment of his rashness.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p23">30. Dead - Mortally wounded. Jehoahaz - Who was younger
than Jehoiakim, yet preferred by the people before the elder brother;
either because Jehoiakim refused the kingdom for fear of Pharaoh, whom
he knew he should hereby provoke. Or because Jehoahaz was the more stout
and warlike prince; whence he is called a lion, <scripRef passage="Ezek xix. 3" id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p23.1" parsed="|Ezek|19|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.19.3">Ezek xix, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p24">32. His fathers - His grand-parents, Manasseh, and Amon.
He restored that idolatry which his father had destroyed. Jerusalem saw
not a good day, after Josiah was laid in his grave; but one trouble came
after another, 'till within two and twenty years it was destroyed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p25">33. In bands - Either, because he presumed to take the
kingdom without his consent: or because he renewed the war against
Pharaoh.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii-p26">34. Jehoiakim - The giving of names was accounted an act
of dominion; which therefore parents did to their children, and
conquerors to their vassals or tributaries.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="67.70%" prev="ii.xiii.xxiv.ii" next="ii.xiii.xxv.i" id="ii.xiii.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XXIV" id="ii.xiii.xxv-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xxv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIV" progress="67.70%" prev="ii.xiii.xxv" next="ii.xiii.xxv.ii" id="ii.xiii.xxv.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.i-p1">Judah severely punished, ver. 1-4. Jehoiakim dies, ver.
5-6. Nebuchadnezzar's conquests, ver. 7. The wicked reign of Jehoiachin,
ver. 8, 9. Nebuchadnezzar takes Jerusalem and carries the people
captive, ver. 10-16. The wicked reign of Zedekiah, ver. 17-20</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="67.71%" prev="ii.xiii.xxv.i" next="ii.xiii.xxvi" id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p1">2. Bands - For Nebuchadnezzar's army was made up of
several nations, who were willing to fight under the banner of such a
puissant and victorious emperor.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p2">3. The sins - Properly and directly for their own sins,
and occasionally for the sins of Manasseh, which had never been charged
upon them, if they had not made them their own by their repetition of
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p3">6. With his fathers - But it is not said, he was buried
with them. No doubt the prophecy of Jeremiah was fulfilled, that he
should not be lamented as his father was, but buried with the burial of
an ass.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p4">7. Came not - In this king's days. He could not now come
to protect the king of Judah, being scarce able to defend his own
kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p5">8. To reign - In his eighth year he began to reign with
his father, who made him king with him as divers other kings of Israel
and Judah had done in times of trouble; and in his eighteenth year he
reigned alone.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p6">12. Went out - Yielded up himself and the city into his
hands; and this by the counsel of Jeremiah, and to his own good. His
reign - Of Nebuchadnezzar's reign; as appears by comparing this with
chap. xxv, 8, and because Jehoiachin reigned not half a year. Had he
made his peace with God, and taken the method that Hezekiah did in the
like case, he needed not to have feared the king of Babylon, but might
have held out with courage, honour and success. But wanting the faith
and piety of an Israelite, he had not the resolution of a man.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p7">13. Vessels - The most and choicest of them, by comparing
this with chap. xxv, 14, 15. Solomon made - Though the city and temple
had been rifled more than once both by the kings of Egypt and Israel,
and by the wicked kings of Judah; yet these golden vessels were
preserved from them, either by the case of the priests, who hid them; or
by the clemency of the conquerors, or by the special providence of God,
disposing their hearts to leave them. Or, if they had been taken away by
any of these kings, they might afterwards be recovered good, at the cost
of the kings of Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p8">14. All - Not simply all, but the best and most
considerable part, as the following words explain it. Captives - Which
are more particularly reckoned up, ver. 16, where there are seven
thousand mighty men, and a thousand smiths; and those mentioned ver. 15,
make up the other two thousand. Craftsmen and smiths - Who might furnish
them with new arms, and thereby give him fresh trouble.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p9">17. Zedekiah - That he might admonish him of (what this
name signifies) the justice of God, which had so severely punished
Jehoiakim for his rebellion; and would no less certainly overtake him,
if he should be guilty of the same perfidiousness.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxv.ii-p10">20. Came to pass - Thus the peoples sins were the true
cause why God gave them wicked kings, whom he suffered to do wickedly,
that they might bring the long-deserved, and threatened punishments upon
themselves and their people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="67.76%" prev="ii.xiii.xxv.ii" next="ii.xiii.xxvi.i" id="ii.xiii.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Kings XXV" id="ii.xiii.xxvi-p0.1" parsed="|2Kgs|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.25" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiii.xxvi-p0.2">XXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXV" progress="67.76%" prev="ii.xiii.xxvi" next="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii" id="ii.xiii.xxvi.i">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.i-p1">Jerusalem is taken, ver. 1-4. Zedekiah taken and
sentenced, ver. 5-7. Nebuzaradan burns the city, breaks down the walls,
and carries away the spoils, with most of the people, ver. 3-17. The
chief officers are put to death, ver. 18-21. The very remnant of the
people is scattered, ver. 22-26. Jehoiachin is countenanced, after
thirty seven years imprisonment, ver. 27-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXV" progress="67.76%" prev="ii.xiii.xxvi.i" next="ii.xiv" id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p1">1. Came - To chastise Zedekiah for his rebellion and
perjury. Built - To keep all supplies of men or provisions from entering
into the city: and that from thence they might shoot darts, or arrows,
or stones.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p2">3. The people - For the common people, but only for the
great men. Now they eat their own children for want of food, <scripRef passage="Lam. iv. 3" id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Lam|4|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lam.4.3">Lam. iv,
3</scripRef>, &amp;c. Jer. in this extremity, earnestly persuaded the
king to surrender; but his heart was hardened to his destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p3">6. Riblah - Where Nebuchadnezzar staid, that he might
both supply the besiegers with men, and military provisions, as their
occasions required; and have an eye to Chaldea, to prevent or suppress
any commotions which might happen there in his absence. They - The
king's officers appointed thereunto, examined his cause, and passed the
following sentence against him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p4">7. Slew, &amp;c. - Tho' they were but children, that this
spectacle, the last he was to behold, might leave a remaining impression
of grief and horror upon his spirit. And in slaying his sons they in
effect declared, that the kingdom was no more, and that he nor any of
his breed were fit to be trusted: therefore not fit to live. Babylon -
Thus two prophecies were fulfilled, which seemed contrary one to the
other, that he should go to Babylon, <scripRef passage="Jer. xxxii. 5" id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Jer|32|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.32.5">Jer. xxxii, 5</scripRef>, xxxiv, 3, and that he should never see Babylon: which
seeming contradiction, because Zedekiah the false prophet could not
reconcile, he concluded both were false, and it seems Zedekiah the king
might stumble at this difficulty.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p5">8. Months, &amp;c. - So the Chaldeans did not put all to
fire and sword, as soon as they had taken the city: but about a month
after, orders were sent, to compleat the destruction of it. This space
God gave them to repent after all the foregoing days of his patience.
But in vain; they still hardened their hearts: and therefore execution
is awarded to the utmost.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p6">9. Burnt the house of the Lord - One of the apocryphal
writers tells us, that Jeremiah got the ark out of the temple, and
conveyed it to a cave in mount Nebo, <scripRef passage="2Macc ii. 4, 5" id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p6.1" parsed="|2Macc|2|4|2|5" osisRef="Bible:2Macc.2.4-2Macc.2.5">2Macc ii, 4, 5</scripRef>. But this is like the other tales of that author, who has no
regard either to truth or probability. For Jeremiah was at this time a
close prisoner. By the burning of the temple God would shew, how little
he cares for the outward pomp of his worship, when the life and power of
religion are gone. About four hundred and thirty years the temple of
Solomon had stood. And it is observed by Josephus, that the second
temple was burnt by the Romans, the same month, and the same day of the
month, that the first temple was burnt by the Chaldeans.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p7">11. People - Whom neither the sword nor famine had
destroyed, who were eight hundred and thirty two persons, <scripRef passage="Jer. lii. 29" id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Jer|52|29|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.52.29">Jer. lii, 29</scripRef>, being members and traders of that city: for it is likely,
there were very many more of the country people fled thither, who were
left with others of their brethren to manure the land. Multitude - Of
the inhabitants of the country.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p8">12. Left of the poor - So while the rich were prisoners
in a strange land, the poor had liberty and peace in their own country!
Thus providence sometimes humbles the proud, and favours them of low
degree.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p9">21. Out of the land - This compleated their calamity,
about eight hundred and sixty years after they were put in possession of
it by Joshua.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p10">22. Gedaliah - A righteous and good man, and a friend to
the prophet Jeremiah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p11">24. Swear - Assured them by his promise and oath, that
they should be kept from the evils which they feared. This he might
safely swear, because he had not only the king of Babylon's promise but
also God's promise deliver'd by Jeremiah. And it might seem, a fair
prospect was opening again. But how soon was the scene changed! This
hopeful settlement is quickly dashed in pieces, not by the Chaldeans,
but by some of themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p12">25. Came - Moved with envy to see so mean a person
advanced into their place. Ten men - Ten captains or officers, and under
each of them many soldiers.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p13">26. Egypt - And here they probably mixt with the
Egyptians by degrees, and were heard of no more as Israelites.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p14">27. Seven and twentieth - Or, on the twenty fifth day, as
it is, <scripRef passage="Jer. lii. 31" id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p14.1" parsed="|Jer|52|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Jer.52.31">Jer.
lii, 31</scripRef>. For then the decree was made, which was executed upon the
twenty seventh day.</p>

<p id="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii-p15">30. All the days of his life - Let none say, they shall
never see good again, because they have long seen little but evil. The
most afflicted know not what blessed turn providence may yet give to
their affairs.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE FIRST BOOK OF CHRONICLES" progress="67.84%" prev="ii.xiii.xxvi.ii" next="ii.xiv.i" id="ii.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1Chr" id="ii.xiv-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.xiv-p0.2">NOTES ON THE FIRST BOOK OF CHRONICLES</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to First Chronicles" progress="67.84%" prev="ii.xiv" next="ii.xiv.ii" id="ii.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.i-p1">THE chief design of these books is, to compleat the history
of the kings of Judah; to gather up fragments of sacred history, which
were omitted in the books of Samuel and Kings; to explain some passages
there mentioned, and to give an exact account of the genealogies. This
was then a work of great necessity, to preserve the distinction of the
tribes and families; that it might appear, Christ came of that nation,
tribe and family, of which he was to be born. And this account, having
been hitherto neglected, is most seasonably mentioned in these books,
compiled by Ezra after the captivity, because this was to be, in a
manner, the last part of the Sacred history of the Old Testament. If
many things herein are now obscure to us, they were not so to the
Hebrew. And all the persons here named were known to them, by those
exact genealogies, which they kept in their several families, and in
public registers. In this first book we have a collection of Sacred
genealogies, from Adam to David, with several histories inserted, chap.
1-9. An account of the translation of the kingdom from Saul to David,
and of David's reign, chap. 10-21. An account of the settlement of
ecclesiastical affairs by David, and of his preparations for building
the temple, chap. 22-29. These are words of days as the Hebrew title
runs, of the best days of the Old Testament Church. But now He is come,
for whose sake the registers were preserved, the Jews have lost all
their genealogies, even that of the priests, so that there is not any
man in the world, that can prove himself of the house of Aaron.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="67.87%" prev="ii.xiv.i" next="ii.xiv.ii.i" id="ii.xiv.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. I" id="ii.xiv.ii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="67.87%" prev="ii.xiv.ii" next="ii.xiv.ii.ii" id="ii.xiv.ii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.i-p1">The descents from Adam to Noah and his sons, ver. 1-4.
The posterity of Japheth and Ham, ver. 5-16. Of Shem to Abraham, ver.
17-27. Abraham's posterity by Ishmael, ver. 28-31. By Keturah, ver. 32,
33. The posterity of Isaac by Esau, ver. 34-54.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="67.88%" prev="ii.xiv.ii.i" next="ii.xiv.iii" id="ii.xiv.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p1">1. Sheth - Adam begat Sheth: and so in the following
particulars. For brevity sake he only mentions their names; but the rest
is easily understood out of the former books. This appears as the
peculiar glory of the Jewish nation, that they alone were able to trace
their pedigree from the first man that God created, which no other
nation pretended to, but abused themselves and their posterity with
fabulous accounts of their originals: the people of Thessaly fancying
that they sprang from stones, the Athenians, that they grew out of the
earth.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p2">5. The sons of Japheh - The historian repeating the
account of the replenishing the earth by the sons of Noah, begins with
those that were strangers to the church, the sons of Japheth, who
peopled Europe, of whom he says little, as the Jews had hitherto little
or no dealings with them. He proceeds to those that had many of them
been enemies to the church, and thence hastens to the line of Abraham,
breaking off abruptly from all the other families of the sons of Noah,
but that of Arphaxad, from whom Christ was to come. The great promise of
the Messiah was transmitted from Adam to Seth, from him to Shem, from
him to Eber, and so to the Jewish nation, who were intrusted above all
nations with that sacred treasure, 'till the promise was performed, and
the Messiah was come: and then that nation was made not a people.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p3">14. The Jebusite - The names which follow until ver. 17,
are not the names of particular persons, but of people or nations. And
all these descended from Canaan, though some of them were afterwards
extinct or confounded with others of their brethren by cohabitation or
mutual marriages, whereby they lost their names: which is the reason why
they are no more mentioned, at least under these names.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p4">17. The sons - Either the name of sons is so taken here
as to include grandsons, or, these words, the children of Aram, are
understood before Uz, out of <scripRef passage="Gen. x. 23" id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Gen|10|23|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.10.23">Gen. x, 23</scripRef>, where they are expressed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p5">18. Begat - Either immediately, or mediately by his son
Cainan, who is expressed, <scripRef passage="Luke iii. 35" id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Luke|3|35|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Luke.3.35">Luke iii, 35</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p6">19. Divided - In their languages and habitations.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p7">24. Arphaxad - Having given a brief and general account
of the original of the world and the people in it, he now returns to a
more large and particular account of the genealogy of Shem, from whom
the Jews were descended.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p8">28. The sons of Abraham - All nations but the seed of
Abraham are already shaken off from this genealogy. Not that we
conclude, no particular persons of any other nation but this found
favour with God. Multitudes will be brought to heaven out of every
nation, and we may hope there were many, very many people in the world,
whose names were in the book of life, tho' they did not spring from the
loins of Abraham.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p9">36. Timna - There is another Timna, the concubine of
Eliphaz, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxvi. 12" id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Gen|36|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.36.12">Gen. xxxvi, 12</scripRef>, but this was one of his sons, though called by the same
name; there being some names common both to men and women in the Hebrew
and in other languages.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p10">38. Seir - One of another nation, prince of the Horims;
whose genealogy is here described, because of that affinity which was
contracted between his and Esau's posterity; and those who were not
united and incorporated with them, were destroyed by them. See <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 12" id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Deut|2|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.12">Deut. ii, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ii.ii-p11">54. These are the dukes of Edom - Let us, in reading
these genealogies, think of the multitudes that have gone thro' the
world, have successively acted their parts in it, and retired into
darkness. All these and all theirs had their day; many of them made a
mighty noise in the world; until their day came to fall, and their place
knew them no more. The paths of death are trodden paths. How soon are we
to tread them?</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="67.94%" prev="ii.xiv.ii.ii" next="ii.xiv.iii.i" id="ii.xiv.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. II" id="ii.xiv.iii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="67.94%" prev="ii.xiv.iii" next="ii.xiv.iii.ii" id="ii.xiv.iii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.i-p1">The sons of Jacob, ver. 1-2. Of Judah, to Jesse, ver.
3-12. Of Jesse, ver. 13-17. Of Caleb, the son of Hezron, ver. 18-20. Of
Hezron, ver. 21-24. Of Jerahmeel down to Elishama, ver. 25-41. Another
branch of Caleb's posterity, ver. 42-49. The sons of Caleb, the son of
Hur, ver. 50-55.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="67.95%" prev="ii.xiv.iii.i" next="ii.xiv.iv" id="ii.xiv.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p1">3. Judah - Whom he puts first, because the best part of
the right of the firstborn, namely, the dominion, was conferred upon
him, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 8" id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|49|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.8">Gen. xlix, 8</scripRef>, and because the Messiah was to come out of his loins.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p2">6. Dara - If these be the same who are mentioned as the
sons of Machol, <scripRef passage="1 Kings iv. 31" id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|1Kgs|4|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.4.31">1 Kings iv, 31</scripRef>, either the same man had two names, Zerah and Machol, as was
usual among the Hebrew: or, one of these was their immediate father, and
the other their grand-father. These are named, because they were the
glory of their father's house. When the Holy Ghost would magnify the
wisdom of Solomon, he saith, he was wiser than these four men. That four
brothers should be so eminent, was a rare thing.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p3">7. Carmi - Who is here mentioned, because he was the son
of Zimri, who is also called Zabdi, <scripRef passage="Josh. vii. 1" id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Josh|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.7.1">Josh. vii, 1</scripRef>. Achar - Called Achan, <scripRef passage="Josh. vii. 1" id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p3.2" parsed="|Josh|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Josh.7.1">Josh. vii, 1</scripRef>, and here Achar, with a little variation for greater
significancy: for Achar signifies a troubler.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p4">13. Eliab - Called also Elihu, chap. xxvii, 18, unless
that was another person, and the word brother be taken more largely for
a kinsman, as it is frequently.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p5">15. Seventh - He had eight sons, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xvi. 10" id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|1Sam|16|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.16.10">1 Sam. xvi, 10</scripRef>, but probably one of them died presently after that
time.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p6">17. Ishmaelite - By birth or habitation, but by
profession an Israelite, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xvii. 25" id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|2Sam|17|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.17.25">2 Sam. xvii, 25</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p7">18. Her sons - The sons of Azubah, who is by way of
distinction called his wife, when Jerioth probably was only his
concubine, and, it may seem, barren: therefore upon Azubah's death he
married another wife. And those other sons of this Caleb mentioned, ver.
42, are his sons by some other wife distinct from all these.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p8">21. Gilead - Of a man so called: a man of noted valour,
and the great champion in those parts.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p9">23. Sons of Machir - Partly to his own sons, and partly
to his son- in-law Jair, who by reason of that dear affection which was
betwixt them, and his forsaking his own tribe and kindred to fight for
them and to dwell with them, is here reckoned as his own son.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p10">24. Tekoa - A known place whose father he is called,
because he was either the progenitor of the people inhabiting there: or,
their prince and ruler: or, the builder of the city.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p11">31. The sons - An expression often used in prophane
authors too, where there is but one son.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p12">35. Jarha - Probably he was not only a proselyte, but an
eminent man: else an Israelite would not have given him his only
daughter.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p13">45. Beth-zur - A place in Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p14">49. Madmannah - This, and divers other following names
are the names of places in Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p15">51. Bethlehem - That is, the inhabitants of
Bethlehem.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iii.ii-p16">55. Scribes - Either civil, who were public notaries,
that wrote and signed legal instruments: or ecclesiastical. And these
were either Levites, or Simeonites, or rather Kenites, and are here
mentioned not as if they were of the tribe of Judah, but because they
dwelt among them, and probably were allied to them by marriages, and so
in a manner incorporated with them.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="68.00%" prev="ii.xiv.iii.ii" next="ii.xiv.iv.i" id="ii.xiv.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. III" id="ii.xiv.iv-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="68.00%" prev="ii.xiv.iv" next="ii.xiv.iv.ii" id="ii.xiv.iv.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.i-p1">The sons of David, ver. 1-9. His successors in the
throne, ver. 10-16. The remains of his family in and after the
captivity, ver. 17-24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="68.00%" prev="ii.xiv.iv.i" next="ii.xiv.v" id="ii.xiv.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p1">3. His wife - Possibly so called because she was his
first, and therefore most proper wife, though her son was born after all
the rest before mentioned, and therefore she and her son are put in the
sixth place, the wive being here named only for the sons sake.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p2">5. Four - All David's children by her, as the text
positively affirms: and therefore Solomon is called her, only son, <scripRef passage="Prov. iv. 3" id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Prov|4|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Prov.4.3">Prov. iv, 3</scripRef>, because she loved him as if he had been so. Ammiel - Called
also Eliam, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xi. 3" id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p2.2" parsed="|2Sam|11|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.11.3">2 Sam. xi, 3</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p3">6. Eliphelet - And he had two other sons called by the
same names, ver.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p4">8, probably they were by different wives: and probably
they were then distinguished by some additional clause or title, which
is here omitted, because the two first were dead before the two second
were born, and therefore the names of the deceased were given to these
to preserve their memory.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p5">8. Nine - There are but seven mentioned, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. v. 14" id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p5.1" parsed="|2Sam|5|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.5.14">2 Sam. v, 14</scripRef>. Two of them are omitted there, because they died very
early, and here we have all the sons of David, which clause is not added
<scripRef passage="2 Sam. v. 13-16" id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p5.2" parsed="|2Sam|5|13|5|16" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.5.13-2Sam.5.16">2 Sam. v,
13-16</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p6">15. Shallum - Which most conceive to be the same who is
called Jehoahaz, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xxiii. 30" id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p6.1" parsed="|2Kgs|23|30|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.23.30">2 Kings xxiii, 30</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p7">16. Zedekiak - This was another Zedekiah. How seldom has
a crown gone in a direct line, from father to son, as it did here, for
seventeen generations! This was the recompense of David's piety. About
the captivity the lineal descent was interrupted, and the crown went
from a nephew to an uncle, a presage of the glory's departing from that
house.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p8">17. Assir - Or, of Jechoniah the captive, which is added
to shew that he begat his son when he was captive in Babylon.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p9">18. Pedaiah - The sentence seems to be short and
imperfect, as is frequent in the Hebrew language, and something is here
understood, as, the sons also of Salathiel were Malchiram and Pedaiah,
&amp;c. as they gather from hence that the same Zerubbabel is called the
son of Pedaiah, ver. 19, and the son (that is, the grandson) of
Salathiel, <scripRef passage="Matt. i. 12" id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Matt|1|12|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.1.12">Matt. i, 12</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p10">19. Their sister - Sister to the two last named sons of
Zerubbabel, namely, by both parents; and therefore named before the
other five, ver.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p11">20, who were her brethren by the father, but not by the
mother.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p12">21. Shechaniah - All these both parents and their sons
blended together, are mentioned as the sons of Hananiah, and branches of
the royal stock.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.iv.ii-p13">22. Six - Including the father. But the Hebrew word,
Shisha, which is rendered six, may be the proper name of one of the sons
of Shemaiah.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="68.04%" prev="ii.xiv.iv.ii" next="ii.xiv.v.i" id="ii.xiv.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. IV" id="ii.xiv.v-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="68.04%" prev="ii.xiv.v" next="ii.xiv.v.ii" id="ii.xiv.v.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.v.i-p1">The prosperity of Shobal, ver. 1-4. Of Ashur, ver. 5-8.
The character and prayer of Jabez, ver. 9, 10. The posterity of Chelah
and others, ver. 11-20. Of Shelah, ver. 21-23. The posterity, cities and
victories of Simeon, ver. 24-43.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="68.05%" prev="ii.xiv.v.i" next="ii.xiv.vi" id="ii.xiv.v.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p1">1. The sons - The posterity: for only Pharez was his
immediate son. But they are all mentioned here only to shew Shobal's
descent from Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p2">9. honourably - For courage, and for fervent piety. She
records this, that it might be a memorandum to herself, to be thankful
to God as long as she lived, for bringing her through that sorrow: and a
memorandum to him, that she bore him into a vale of tears, in which he
might expect few days and full of trouble. And the sorrow in his name
might serve to put a seriousness upon his spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p3">10. Called - When he was undertaking some great and
dangerous service. Enlarge - Drive out these Canaanites, whom thou hast
commanded us to root out. Grieve - That it may not oppress and overcome
me: more is understood than is expressed. He useth this expression in
allusion to his name, which signifies grief. And God granted, &amp;c. -
Prospered him remarkably in his undertakings, in his studies, in his
worldly business, and in his conflicts with the Canaanites.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p4">12. Rechab - From these are sprung the present
inhabitants of Rechab, a town not elsewhere mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p5">14. Father - Of the inhabitants of the valley.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p6">21. Shelah - Having treated of the posterity of Judah by
Pharez, and by Zara, he now comes to his progeny by Shelah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p7">22. Had dominion - Which they ruled in the name and for
the use of the kings of Judah, to whom Moab was subject from David's
time. Ancient things - The sense is those blessed times are long since
past. Our ancestors had the dominion over the Heathen, but their
degenerate posterity are slaves in Chaldea, were they are employed as
potters or gardeners, or in other servile works.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p8">23. There are - He seems to oppose their present
servitude to their former glory, and to shew their mean spirits that had
rather tarry among the Heathen to do their drudgery, than return to
Jerusalem to serve God and enjoy their freedom. The king - Of Babylon:
esteeming it a greater honour to serve that earthly monarch in the
meanest employments, than to serve the king of kings in his temple.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p9">27. Of Judah - The tribe of Simeon did not increase
proportionably to the tribe of Judah in which they dwelt; as appears by
those two catalogues, <scripRef passage="Num. i. 22" id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p9.1" parsed="|Num|1|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.1.22">Num. i, 22</scripRef>; xxvi, 14, which is to be ascribed to God's curse upon them,
delivered by the mouth of holy Jacob, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlix. 5-7" id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p9.2" parsed="|Gen|49|5|49|7" osisRef="Bible:Gen.49.5-Gen.49.7">Gen. xlix, 5-7</scripRef>, and signified by Moses's neglect of them when he blessed
all the other tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p10">31. Their cities - Several of these cities though given
to Simeon by Joshua, yet through the sloth or cowardice of that tribe,
were not taken from the Philistines, until David's time, who took some
of them; and, the Simeonites having justly forfeited their right to them
by their neglect, gave them to his own tribe. For it is evident
concerning Ziklag, one of them, that it was in the Philistines hands in
David's time, and by them given to him, and by him annexed to the tribe
of Judah, <scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxvii. 6" id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p10.1" parsed="|1Sam|27|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.27.6">1 Sam. xxvii, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.v.ii-p11">40. Fat pasture, &amp;c. - Those who thus dwelt (as we
do) in a fruitful country, and whose land is wide and quiet and
peaceable, have reason to own themselves indebted to that God, who
appoints the bounds of our habitation. Of Ham - The Canaanites, who
descended from Ham. And accordingly these words contain a reason, why
they went and possessed this place, because it was not in the hands of
their brethren of Judah, but in the possession of that people which they
had authority to expel.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="68.11%" prev="ii.xiv.v.ii" next="ii.xiv.vi.i" id="ii.xiv.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. V" id="ii.xiv.vi-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="68.11%" prev="ii.xiv.vi" next="ii.xiv.vi.ii" id="ii.xiv.vi.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.vi.i-p1">The genealogies of Reuben, ver. 1-10. Of Gad, ver. 11-17.
Joined together they conquer the Hagarites, ver. 18-22. Of the half
tribe of Manasseh, ver. 23, 24. They are led captive by the king of
Assyria, ver. 26, 26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="68.11%" prev="ii.xiv.vi.i" next="ii.xiv.vii" id="ii.xiv.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.vi.ii-p1">1. Sons of Israel - This is added emphatically, because
they were treated as if they had been the immediate sons of Jacob. Not
reckoned - This is the second reason, which sheweth both why Reuben's
genealogy was not first mentioned; and if another tribe was to be ranked
before it, why that was Judah, and not Joseph, because the order of
their genealogy was not to be ruled by the birthright, but by an higher
privilege, which was given to Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.vi.ii-p2">2. Judah - Not the person, but the tribe of Judah.
Prevailed - Excelled the other tribes, especially in the following
privilege.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.vi.ii-p3">9. Euphrates - From Jordan and the wilderness beyond it
unto Euphrates. Or, of the wilderness, which lies towards or reacheth to
the river Euphrates, namely, the great wilderness of Kedemoth, <scripRef passage="Deut. ii. 26" id="ii.xiv.vi.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Deut|2|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.2.26">Deut. ii, 26</scripRef>, which was extended far and wide towards Euphrates: for that
was the eastern border of Reuben's possession, and not Euphrates, to
which their habitation never reached. Multiplied - Which forced them to
enlarge their habitation as far as they could towards Euphrates.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.vi.ii-p4">10. They made war - Thus God did for his people, as he
promised them. He cast out the enemy from before them by little and
little, and gave them their land as they had occasion for it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.vi.ii-p5">14. These - These seven last named.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.vi.ii-p6">20. Helped - By God, ver. 22, who gave them extraordinary
courage and success.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.vi.ii-p7">22. Was of God - Undertaken in his fear, and carried on
in a dependence on him. Then we may expect to prosper in any enterprize,
and then only, when we take God along with us.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="68.14%" prev="ii.xiv.vi.ii" next="ii.xiv.vii.i" id="ii.xiv.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. VI" id="ii.xiv.vii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="68.14%" prev="ii.xiv.vii" next="ii.xiv.vii.ii" id="ii.xiv.vii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.vii.i-p1">The first fathers of the tribe of Levi, ver. 1-3. The
line of the priests from Aaron to the captivity, ver. 4-15. Of some
other families, ver. 16-30. The work of the Levites, ver. 31-48 Of the
priests, ver. 49-53. The cities of the priests and Levites, ver. 54-
81.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="68.14%" prev="ii.xiv.vii.i" next="ii.xiv.viii" id="ii.xiv.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.vii.ii-p1">10. The priest's office - So did all the rest, but it is
implied that he did it worthily, he filled his place, and valiantly
discharged his office in Uzziah's time. Solomon built - In Solomon's
temple; so called to distinguish it from the second temple which was
built or in building when these books were written.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.vii.ii-p2">44. Ethan - Called also Jeduthun, chap. ix, 16; <scripRef passage="2 Chron. xxxv. 15" id="ii.xiv.vii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Chr|35|15|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.35.15">2 Chron. xxxv, 15</scripRef>, and in the titles of divers psalms.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.vii.ii-p3">54. Castles - So called, not only because, walled and
well guarded by the country; but because they and their possessions were
in a particular manner the care of divine providence. As God was their
portion, so God was their protector. And a cottage will be a castle to
those that abide under the shadow of the Almighty. The lot - Or, the
first lot.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.vii.ii-p4">66. Coasts - Or, of their borders, of their country
contained within its borders.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="68.16%" prev="ii.xiv.vii.ii" next="ii.xiv.viii.i" id="ii.xiv.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. VII" id="ii.xiv.viii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="68.16%" prev="ii.xiv.viii" next="ii.xiv.viii.ii" id="ii.xiv.viii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.viii.i-p1">The prosperity of Issachar, ver. 1-5. Of Benjamin, ver.
6-12. Of Naphtali, ver. 13. Of Manasseh, ver. 14-19. Of Ephraim, ver.
20-29. Of Asher, ver. 30-40.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="68.16%" prev="ii.xiv.viii.i" next="ii.xiv.ix" id="ii.xiv.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p1">6. Three - They were ten, <scripRef passage="Gen. xlvi. 25" id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Gen|46|25|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.46.25">Gen. xlvi, 25</scripRef>, and five of them are named, chap. chap. viii, 1, but here
only three are mentioned, either because these were most eminent; or
because the other families are now extinct.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p2">7. Heads - Each of them head of that family to which he
belonged. For it may seem by comparing this with chap. viii, 3, &amp;c.
that these were not the immediate sons of Belah, but his Grand- children
descended each from a several father.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p3">14. She - His wife; his concubine is here opposed to
her.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p4">15. Second - Of the second son or grandson of Machir; for
so Zelophehad was. Had daughters - Only daughters, and no sons.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p5">17. These - Ashriel and Zelophehad, named ver. 14, 15,
the relative being here referred to the remoter antecedent; as is
frequent in the Hebrew.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p6">18. His - Gilead's sister. Mahalah - Understand, and
Shemida, out of the next verse.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p7">21. Slew - This history is not recorded else where in
scripture, but it is in the ancient Hebrew writers. The Philistines (one
of whose cities Gath was) and the Egyptians were next neighbours; and in
those ancient times it was usual for such to make inroads one into
another's country, and to carry thence what prey they could take. And as
the Philistines had probably made such inroads formerly into Egypt, and
particularly into the land of Goshen, which was the utmost part of Egypt
bordering upon the Philistines land; so the Israelites might requite
them in the like kind: and particularly the children of Ephraim, to
their own loss. And this seems to have happened a little before the
Egyptian persecution, and before the reign of that new king mentioned <scripRef passage="Exod. i. 8" id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Exod|1|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Exod.1.8">Exod. i, 8</scripRef>. And this clause, that were born in that land, may be added
emphatically, as the motive which made them more resolute in their fight
with the Ephraimites, because they fought in, and for their own land,
wherein all their wealth and concerns lay.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.viii.ii-p8">23. Bare a son - Thus the breach was in some measure
repaired, by the addition of another son in his old age. When God thus
restores comfort to his mourners, he makes glad according to the days
wherein he afflicted, setting the mercies over against the crosses, we
ought to observe the kindness of his providence. Yet the joy that a man
was born into his family could not make him forget his grief. For he
gives a melancholy name to his son, Beriah, that is, in trouble: for he
was born when the family was in mourning. It is good to have in
remembrance the affliction and the misery which are past, that our souls
may be humbled within us.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="68.21%" prev="ii.xiv.viii.ii" next="ii.xiv.ix.i" id="ii.xiv.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. VIII" id="ii.xiv.ix-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="68.21%" prev="ii.xiv.ix" next="ii.xiv.ix.ii" id="ii.xiv.ix.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.ix.i-p1">Some of the heads of the tribe of Benjamin, ver. 1-32.
The family of Saul, ver. 33-40.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="68.21%" prev="ii.xiv.ix.i" next="ii.xiv.x" id="ii.xiv.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.ix.ii-p1">6. These - These following, ver. 7, because he here
speaks of them who were removed. He describes the sons of Benjamin by
the places of their habitation, without an exact account of their
parents; because their genealogies were broken by that almost total
extirpation of this tribe, <scripRef passage="Judg. xx. 29-48" id="ii.xiv.ix.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Judg|20|29|20|48" osisRef="Bible:Judg.20.29-Judg.20.48">Judg. xx, 29-48</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ix.ii-p2">28. Heads of the fathers, &amp;c. - Particular notice is
taken of these, that others, at their return from captivity, might be
induced to settle there too, which it seems few were willing to do,
because it was the post of danger. Many great and mighty nations were
then upon earth, and many illustrious men in them, whose names are
buried in perpetual oblivion, while the names of multitudes of the
Israel of God, are here carefully preserved in everlasting remembrance:
a figure of God's writing the names of his spiritual Israel, in the
Lamb's book of life.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.ix.ii-p3">40. Archers - Hebrew. that tread the bow; for the bows of
steel, which these used, required great strength to bend them; which
therefore they did by treading the bow with their feet, and pulling the
string with both their hands.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="68.23%" prev="ii.xiv.ix.ii" next="ii.xiv.x.i" id="ii.xiv.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. IX" id="ii.xiv.x-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="68.23%" prev="ii.xiv.x" next="ii.xiv.x.ii" id="ii.xiv.x.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.x.i-p1">The chief of Judah, Benjamin. Ephraim and Manasseh, who
returned from captivity and dwelt at Jerusalem, ver. 1-9. The priests,
ver. 10-13. The Levites, ver. 14-16. Their various offices in the
temple, ver. 17-34. The family of Saul, ver. 35-44.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="68.23%" prev="ii.xiv.x.i" next="ii.xiv.xi" id="ii.xiv.x.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p1">1. The book - In the publick records, wherein there was
an account of that kingdom, and of the several families in it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p2">2. The first - After the return from Babylon. Dwelt -
That took possession of their own lands and cities, which had been
formerly allotted them; but of late years had been taken from them for
their sins, and possessed by other people. Israelites - The common
people of Judah and Israel, called here by the general name of
Israelites, which was given them before that unhappy division of the
kingdoms, and now is restored to them when the Israelites are united
with the Jews in one and the same commonwealth, that so all the names
and signs of their former division might be blotted out. And though the
generality of the ten tribes were yet in captivity, yet divers of them
upon Cyrus's general proclamation, associated themselves, and returned
with those of Judah and Benjamin. Levites - These took possession of the
cities belonging to them, as they had need and opportunity. Nethinims -
A certain order of men, either Gibeonites or others joined with them,
devoted to the service of God, and of his house, and of the priests and
Levites; who, that they might attend upon their work without
distraction, had certain places and possessions given to them; which
they are now said to repossess.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p3">4. Ammihud - That there is so great a diversity of names
between this catalogue and that of <scripRef passage="Nehem xi. 4-36" id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Neh|11|4|11|36" osisRef="Bible:Neh.11.4-Neh.11.36">Nehem xi, 4-36</scripRef>, may be ascribed to two causes:</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p4">1. to the custom of the Hebrew, who used
frequently to give several names to one person: and,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p5">2. to the change of times; for here they
are named who came up at the first return but many of those in Nehemiah
might be such as returned afterward, and came and dwelt either instead
of the persons here named, or with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p6">9. And fifty-six - They are reckoned but nine hundred and
twenty- eight in <scripRef passage="Neh. xi. 8" id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Neh|11|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.11.8">Neh. xi, 8</scripRef>, either because there he mentions only those that were by
lot determined to dwell at Jerusalem, to whom he here adds those who
freely offered themselves to it; or because some of the persons first
placed there were dead, or removed from Jerusalem upon some emergent
occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p7">11. The ruler - Or, a ruler in the house of God: not the
high-priest, who was Ezra, <scripRef passage="Ezra iii. 8" id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Ezra|3|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.3.8">Ezra iii, 8</scripRef>, but a chief ruler under him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p8">13. Able men - Hebrew. mighty men of valour: which is
here noted as an excellent qualification for their place; because the
priests might meet with great opposition in the discharge of their
office, in the execution of the censures upon all impure persons without
exception, and in preserving sacred things from violation by the touch
of forbidden hands.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p9">17. Porters - Whose office it was to keep all the gates
of the temple, that no unclean person or thing might enter into it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p10">18. King's gate - In the east-gate of the temple, which
was so called, because the kings of Judah used to go to the temple
through that gate. Under this gate he comprehends all the rest, which
also were guarded by these porters. Companies - Or, according to the
courses. They kept the gates successively, according to that method into
which the Levites were distributed, for the more convenient management
of their several offices; among which this of the porters was one.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p11">19. Tabernacle - Namely, in time past, when the
tabernacle was standing, before the temple was built. Fathers - The
Kohathites. Host - When the Israelites were in the wilderness, encamped
in a military manner round about the tabernacle, with whom these were
then placed. Entry - Of the veil by which they entered into the
tabernacle; which he calls the entry because then there were no gates.
The meaning is, that all things were now restored to their primitive
order; and the several persons took those offices upon them, which their
ancestors had before them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p12">21. Was - In the time of David, as the following verse
sheweth. Porter - Chief porter. The door - Of the door which led out of
the priests court into the tabernacle, in which the ark was placed.
Before the temple was built, they had a mean and moveable tent, which
they made use of in the mean time. They that cannot yet have a temple,
let them be thankful for a tabernacle, and make the best use of it.
Never let God's work be left undone, for want of a place to do it
in.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p13">22. Villages - Where their usual residence was, and
whence they came to Jerusalem in their courses. Ordain - In the times of
the Judges there was much disorder both in the Jewish state and church,
and the Levites came to the tabernacle promiscuously, and as their
inclinations or occasions brought them. But Samuel observing they were
greatly increased, began to think of establishing order in their
ministration. And these intentions of his probably were communicated to
David, who after his own peaceable settlement in his throne, revived and
perfected Samuel's design, and took care to put it in execution.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p14">23. The oversight - Namely, in David's time. Tabernacle -
This is added to explain what he means by the house of the Lord, not
that tabernacle which David had set up for the ark; but that more solemn
tabernacle, which Moses had made by God's express command; which in
David's time was at Gibeon; in which God was worshipped until the temple
was built. Wards - By turns or courses.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p15">25. To come - From their several villages to the place of
worship. Seven days - Every seventh day the courses were changed, and
the new comers were to tarry 'till the next sabbath day. With them - To
be with them, with the chief porters, who alway's abode in the place of
God's worship.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p16">26. Set office - These were constantly upon the place, in
the execution of their office, that they might oversee the inferior
porters in their work. Treasuries - In which the sacred utensils and
other treasures belonging to the temple, were kept.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p17">30. The ointment - This is added to shew, that though the
Levites were intrusted with the keeping of this ointment, yet none but
the priests could make it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p18">31. The pans - Was to take care that fine flour might be
provided, that when occasion required they might make cakes in pans.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p19">33. These - Others of the Levites; of whose several
offices he had spoken before. Are - Or rather, were; which is
understood, all along in the foregoing and following verses. Chambers -
That they might be ready to come whensoever they were called to the
service of God in the tabernacle. Free - From all trouble and
employment, that they might wholly attend upon the proper work. That
work - Either composing or ordering sacred songs; or actually singing;
or teaching others to sing them. Day and night - Continually, and
particularly in the morning and evening, the two times appointed for
solemn service. Thus was God continually praised, as it is fit he should
be, who is continually doing us good.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p20">34. Jerusalem - Upon their return from Babylon they were
not suffered to chuse their habitations in the country, as others were,
but were obliged to settle themselves at Jerusalem, that they might
constantly attend upon God's service there.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.x.ii-p21">35. Maachah - In this and the following verses, he
repeats Saul's genealogy, that he might make way for the following
history.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="68.36%" prev="ii.xiv.x.ii" next="ii.xiv.xi.i" id="ii.xiv.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. X" id="ii.xiv.xi-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="68.36%" prev="ii.xiv.xi" next="ii.xiv.xi.ii" id="ii.xiv.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xi.i-p1">The overthrow and death of Saul, ver. 1-7. The triumph of
the Philistines, ver. 8-10. The men of Jabesh-gilead take down and bury
the bodies of Saul and his sons, ver. 11, 12. The reason of Saul's
death, ver. 13, 14.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="68.36%" prev="ii.xiv.xi.i" next="ii.xiv.xii" id="ii.xiv.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xi.ii-p1">1. The men of Israel fled, &amp;c. - Thus princes sin and
the people suffer for it. No doubt there was enough in them to deserve
it. But that which divine justice had chiefly an eye to, was the sin of
Saul. Great men should in an especial manner, take heed of provoking
God's wrath. For if they kindle that fire, they know not how many may be
consumed by it for their sakes.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xi.ii-p2">6. His house - All his children, then present with him,
namely, his three sons, for Ishbosheth and Mephiboshieth were not
slain.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xi.ii-p3">10. Temple of Dagon - If we give not God the glory of our
successes, even Philistines will rise up in judgment with us and condemn
us. Shall Dagon have so great a place in their triumphs, and the true
God be forgotten in ours?</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xi.ii-p4">12. Seven days - Every day 'till evening, after the
manner of the Jewish fasts.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xi.ii-p5">13. The word - Against God's express command: which is a
great aggravation of any sin. Familiar spirit - Which also was contrary
to a manifest command, <scripRef passage="Levit xix. 31" id="ii.xiv.xi.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Lev|19|31|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.19.31">Levit xix, 31</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xi.ii-p6">14. Inquired not - He did in some sort, but not in a
right manner, not humbly and penitently, not diligently and
importunately, not patiently and perseveringly. Nor 'till he was brought
to the last extremity. And then it was too late.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="68.38%" prev="ii.xiv.xi.ii" next="ii.xiv.xii.i" id="ii.xiv.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XI" id="ii.xiv.xii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="68.38%" prev="ii.xiv.xii" next="ii.xiv.xii.ii" id="ii.xiv.xii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xii.i-p1">David is made king, ver. 1-3. He takes the castle of
Zion, ver. 4-9. A catalogue of his mighty men, ver. 10-47.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="68.39%" prev="ii.xiv.xii.i" next="ii.xiv.xiii" id="ii.xiv.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p1">6. Chief - Before this he was one of David's chief
captains: but now he is made captain-general of all the forces of Israel
and Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p2">10. Mighty men - Yet David ascribed his success, not to
the hosts he had, but to the Lord of hosts: not to the mighty men that
were with him, but to the mighty God, whole presence with us is all in
all.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p3">11. Slain - By his own hand, five hundred more being
slain by others then joining with him, who pursued the victory, both
which sums make up the eight hundred, numbered <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xxiii. 8" id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|2Sam|23|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.23.8">2 Sam. xxiii, 8</scripRef>. The slaughter of all is justly ascribed to him, because it
was the effect of his valour.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p4">18. Would not drink of it - That water which he thought
too precious for his own drinking, he poured out to the Lord for a
drink-offering. If we have any thing better than other, let God be
honoured with it, who is the best and should have the best.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p5">19. Shall I drink the blood, &amp;c. - It put him into
the utmost confusion, to think three brave men should hazard their
lives, to fetch water for him. In his account, it turns the water into
blood. It is to the honour of great men, not to be prodigal of the blood
of those they employ.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p6">21. Attained not - He did not equal them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p7">41. Uriah - The last of that catalogue in <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xxiii. 39" id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|2Sam|23|39|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.23.39">2 Sam. xxiii, 39</scripRef>. But here some others are added to the number, because
though they were not of the thirty, yet they were men of great valour
and renown amongst David's commanders.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xii.ii-p8">42. Thirty - Thirty captains who were under him as their
colonel.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="68.41%" prev="ii.xiv.xii.ii" next="ii.xiv.xiii.i" id="ii.xiv.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XII" id="ii.xiv.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="68.41%" prev="ii.xiv.xiii" next="ii.xiv.xiii.ii" id="ii.xiv.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.i-p1">The companies that came to David at Ziklag, ver. 1-22.
The armies that came to him at Hebron, ver. 23-40.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="68.41%" prev="ii.xiv.xiii.i" next="ii.xiv.xiv" id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p1">2. Even - Of Saul's own tribe: who were moved hereto by
God's spirit, by the conscience of their duty to David; and by their
observation of God's departure from Saul, and of his special presence
with David.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p2">4. Thirty - Who came attended with thirty valiant
Benjamites, and was their commander.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p3">17. The God of our fathers - He calls God, the God of our
fathers, both his fathers and theirs; thus he minds them, not to deal
ill with him; for they were both descendents from the same patriarchs,
and servants of the same God. And thus he encourages himself to believe,
that God would right him, if he was abused. For he was the God of his
fathers; therefore a blessing was entailed upon him: and a God to all
Israel in particular, as well as a Judge to all the earth.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p4">18. The Spirit - Not only saving graces, but other
heroical and generous motions are ascribed to God's spirit, which here
stirred up in him a more that ordinary greatness of mind and
resolution.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p5">20. As - As he returned from the camp of the Philistines
to Ziklag.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p6">21. Against - Against the Amalekites who had taken and
burnt Ziklag, whom David and his six hundred men were now pursuing.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p7">22. That time - While he was at Ziklag, and in his march
to Hebron, and principally at Hebron. Like - Innumerable, like the stars
or angels, both which are called God's hosts.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p8">24. Six thousand, &amp;c. - Who came hither in the name
of their brethren; for that whole tribe stuck to David.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p9">27. Jehoida - Not the high-priest, for that was Abiathar,
<scripRef passage="1 Sam. xxiii. 6" id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|1Sam|23|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Sam.23.6">1 Sam.
xxiii, 6</scripRef>, but one of eminent place under him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p10">29. Kept the ward - endeavoured to keep the crown in
Saul's family.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p11">31. Manasseh - Which was within Jordan: for of the other
half beyond Jordan he speaks, ver. 37. By name - Who were not ashamed
publickly to own David by putting their names to some paper presented to
them for that purpose.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p12">32. The times - They understood public affairs, the
temper of the nation, and the tendencies of the present events. And they
shewed their wisdom at this time; for as they had adhered to Saul while
he lived, as knowing the time was not yet come for David to take
possession of the kingdom: and as they could not join David, while Abner
lived, and had the command of the other tribes wherewith they were
encompassed, so as soon as he was dead, and they had opportunity to
declare themselves, they owned David for their king.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiii.ii-p13">33. Double heart - They were sincerely loyal, and did not
dissemble with David, pretending to be for him, while in their hearts
they favoured Saul's family. And none had any separate interests, but
all were for the public good.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="68.46%" prev="ii.xiv.xiii.ii" next="ii.xiv.xiv.i" id="ii.xiv.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XIII" id="ii.xiv.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="68.46%" prev="ii.xiv.xiv" next="ii.xiv.xiv.ii" id="ii.xiv.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xiv.i-p1">David brings up the ark from Kirjath-jearim, ver. 1-8.
Uzza being smitten, it is left at the house of Obed-edom, ver. 9-14.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="68.46%" prev="ii.xiv.xiv.i" next="ii.xiv.xv" id="ii.xiv.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xiv.ii-p1">2. David said - After this was proposed by the king and
accepted by the people, this great assembly was dismissed, only some of
them David reserved to go with him against Jerusalem, which accordingly
he did, and succeeded in his enterprize. But before this resolution
could be executed, the Philistines came and fought twice with David, as
is related <scripRef passage="2 Sam. v. 17, 22" id="ii.xiv.xiv.ii-p1.1" parsed="|2Sam|5|17|0|0;|2Sam|5|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.5.17 Bible:2Sam.5.22">2 Sam. v, 17, 22</scripRef>, &amp;c. and here chap. chap. xiv, 8, &amp;c. And after they
were repulsed with great loss and shame, David sets upon the execution
of what he had resolved, and in order to it calls another general
assembly of the people. Of the Lord - If this translation of the ark be
pleasing to God. Are left - After the great desolations and destructions
which God for their sins had made among them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiv.ii-p2">3. For, &amp;c. - The ark was then neglected; and the
generality of the people contented themselves with going to Gibeon and
offering sacrifices there, not caring, though the ark, the soul of the
tabernacle, was in another place. As soon as David had power in his
hand, he would use it for the advancement of religion. It ought to be
the first care of those that are enriched or preferred, to honour God
with their honours, and to serve him and the interests of his kingdom
among men, with their wealth and power.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiv.ii-p3">6. That is - The same city was called by both names.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiv.ii-p4">10. Put his hand, &amp;c. - Let the case of Uzza warn us,
to take heed of presumption or rashness with regard to holy things; and
not to think, that a right intention will justify a wrong action.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiv.ii-p5">11. Perez-uzza - That is, the breach of Uzza. Let David's
displeasure on this occasion caution us, to watch over our spirit, lest
when God reproves us, instead of submitting to God, we quarrel with him.
If God be angry with us, shall we dare to be angry with him?</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xiv.ii-p6">14. And the Lord blessed,&amp;c. - Let this encourage us
to welcome God's ordinance into our houses, believing the ark is a guest
no body shall lose by. Nor let it be the less precious to us, for its
being to others a rock of offense.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="68.50%" prev="ii.xiv.xiv.ii" next="ii.xiv.xv.i" id="ii.xiv.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XIV" id="ii.xiv.xv-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="68.50%" prev="ii.xiv.xv" next="ii.xiv.xvi" id="ii.xiv.xv.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xv.i-p1">David is confirmed in his kingdom, ver. 1, 2. His wives
and children, ver. 3-7. His victories over the Philistines, ver.
8-17.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="68.50%" prev="ii.xiv.xv.i" next="ii.xiv.xvi.i" id="ii.xiv.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XV" id="ii.xiv.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="68.50%" prev="ii.xiv.xvi" next="ii.xiv.xvi.ii" id="ii.xiv.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.i-p1">David prepares to bring up the ark, ver. 1-24. It is
brought up, ver. 25-28. Michal despises him, ver. 29.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="68.50%" prev="ii.xiv.xvi.i" next="ii.xiv.xvii" id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p1">1. Houses - A palace consisting of many houses or
apartments for his several wives and children. A tent - He did not fetch
the tabernacle of Moses from Gibeon, because he intended forthwith to
build the temple.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p2">5. The sons - Of Amram or Izhar, Kohath's sons, <scripRef passage="Num. iii. 27" id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Num|3|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.3.27">Num. iii, 27</scripRef>, otherwise Elizaphan, ver. 8, and Hebron, ver. 9, and
Uzziel, ver. 10, were Kohath's children.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p3">11. The Priests - Abiathar the high-priest, and Zadok the
second priest.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p4">18. Second degree - The first rank of sacred musicians
being those three famous persons named ver. 17, next to whom were these
here named. Porters - who were to keep the doors of the tabernacle and
courts, but with all were instructed in musick, that when these were
free from attendance upon their proper office, they might not be idle
nor unprofitable in God's house.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p5">20. Alamoth - Or, with Alamoth which is thought to be the
name of an instrument of musick; or of a certain tune, or note, or part
in musick. The certain signification of it is not now known; and the
like may be said of Sheminith, ver. 21.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p6">21. To excel - Which word may be added to note the
excellency of that instrument, or part of musick; or that there was a
greater extension or elevation of the voice than in the former. This way
of praising God by musical instruments, had not hitherto been in use.
But David instituted it by divine direction, and added it to the other
ordinances of that dispensation.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p7">22. For song - He was the moderator of the musick,
instructing them when and how to lift up their voices, or change their
notes, or make their stops.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p8">23. Door-keepers - They were appointed to keep the door
of the tent in which the ark was to be kept, that no unallowed person
might press in and touch it; and in like manner they were to attend upon
the ark in the way, and to guard it from the press and touch of prophane
hands; for which end these two went before the ark, is their other two
brethren mentioned in the close of ver. 24, came after it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p9">26. Helped - Encouraging them in their work with some
comfortable sign of his presence with them. In all our religious
exercises, we must derive help from heaven. God's ministers that bare
the vessels of the Lord, have special need of divine help in their
ministrations, that God may be glorified thereby, and the people
edified.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvi.ii-p10">27. Linen - With a linen ephod. This circumstance is
repeated, because it was an unusual thing for one, who was no Levite, to
wear a Levitical garment.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="68.55%" prev="ii.xiv.xvi.ii" next="ii.xiv.xvii.i" id="ii.xiv.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XVI" id="ii.xiv.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="68.55%" prev="ii.xiv.xvii" next="ii.xiv.xvii.ii" id="ii.xiv.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xvii.i-p1">David's sacrifices and alms, ver. 1-3. He appoints
Levites to minister before the ark, ver. 4-6. His psalm of thanksgiving,
ver. 7-36. Ministers and others are appointed to attend the ark
continually, ver. 37-43.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="68.55%" prev="ii.xiv.xvii.i" next="ii.xiv.xviii" id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii-p1">4. To thank, and praise - All our rejoicings should
express themselves in thanksgivings to him, from whom all our comforts
are received.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii-p2">7. First - Hereby it is implied, that after this he
delivered many other psalms into their hands, to be sung by them to the
praise of God in his public service. We shall find it in the same words,
in <scripRef passage="Psalm cv. 1-15" id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Ps|105|1|105|15" osisRef="Bible:Ps.105.1-Ps.105.15">Psalm cv, 1-15</scripRef> and <scripRef passage="Psalm 9" id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii-p2.2" parsed="|Ps|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.9">Psalm 9</scripRef>vi, 1-11, all but the three last verses.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii-p3">35. From the Heathen - This psalm or prayer was made by
David for the use of the church, not only in that present time, but in
future ages, in which David foresaw by the spirit of prophecy, the
Israelites would forsake God, and for their apostacy be dispersed among
the Heathens. In the midst of our praises, we must not forget to pray
for those servants of God that are in distress. When we are rejoicing in
God's favours, we should remember our afflicted brethren, and pray for
their deliverance as our own. We are members one of another.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii-p4">37. He left - He appointed them their work and station
there. Indeed no incense was burnt there, nor sacrifices offered,
because the altars were not there. But David's prayers were directed as
incense, and the lifting up of his hands as an evening sacrifice. So
early did spiritual worship take place of ceremonial.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii-p5">39. Zadok - The chief-priest at Gibeon, where the
tabernacle and altar made by Moses still were, where also the ordinary
sacrifices were offered, and the stated worship of God was performed, as
the extraordinary worship was before the ark upon great occasions, as
when God was consulted, which was to be done before the ark and by the
high-priest, who was Abiathar.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii-p6">40. Which he commanded Israel - These must be kept up;
because however in their own nature they were inferior to prayer and
praise, yet as they were types of the mediation of Christ, the
observance of them was of mighty importance.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xvii.ii-p7">42. Of God - Appropriated to the worship of God; not such
as they used on other occasions. Between common mirth and holy joy,
there is a vast difference: and the limits and distances between them
must be carefully kept up.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="68.59%" prev="ii.xiv.xvii.ii" next="ii.xiv.xviii.i" id="ii.xiv.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XVII" id="ii.xiv.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="68.59%" prev="ii.xiv.xviii" next="ii.xiv.xviii.ii" id="ii.xiv.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xviii.i-p1">God forbids David's building him an house, ver. 1-10.
Gives him a gracious promise, ver. 11-15. David's prayer, ver.
16-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="68.59%" prev="ii.xiv.xviii.i" next="ii.xiv.xix" id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p1">1. Now - This whole chapter is explained, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. vii. 1-29" id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|2Sam|7|1|7|29" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.7.1-2Sam.7.29">2 Sam. vii, 1-29</scripRef>, where the same things are recorded with little
variation.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p2">10. Furthermore, &amp;c. - Must he think, that his
purpose was in vain, and that he should lose the reward of it? No: it
being God's act that prevented the execution of it, he shall be as fully
recompensed as if it had been done.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p3">14. Settle him - In the temple, this expression agrees
but imperfectly with Solomon, or his successors, but strictly and
properly with Christ, to whom alone that promise also of an everlasting
establishment in this kingdom belongs. Kingdom - In God's kingdom in a
large and general sense. And this, as well as the former phrase,
singularly belongs to the Messiah, who was not only to be the king of
Israel, but also of all nations. This is an intimation of that great
mystery which is more fully revealed in the new testament, namely, that
Christ, is the head, or king of all God's church, consisting of Jews and
Gentiles, and of all nations, and indeed of all creatures, all which is
God's kingdom, and by him given to his son our blessed Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p4">16. Who am I, &amp;c. - We have here David's solemn
address to God, in answer to his gracious message. How humbly does he
here abase himself, and acknowledge his own unworthiness! How highly
does he advance the name of God, and admire his condescending favour?
With what devout affections does he magnify the God of Israel: with what
assurance build upon the promise! What an example is this of believing,
fervent prayer! The Lord enable us all thus to seek him!</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p5">18. The honour of thy servant - The honour God puts upon
his servants, by taking them into covenant and communion with himself,
is so great, that they need not, they cannot desire to be more highly
honoured.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p6">19. Servant's sake - In <scripRef passage="2 Sam. vii. 21" id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|2Sam|7|21|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.7.21">2 Sam. vii, 21</scripRef>, it is, for thy words sake, for the sake of thy promise made
to thy servant.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p7">24. A God - He is really to his people that which he hath
styled himself, their God, having taken such care of them, and shewed
such mercy and truth to them, as fully answered that title.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xviii.ii-p8">27. Blessed forever - David's prayer concludes, as God's
promise did, ver. 14, with that which is forever. God's word looks at
things eternal. And so should our desires and hopes.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="68.63%" prev="ii.xiv.xviii.ii" next="ii.xiv.xix.i" id="ii.xiv.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XVIII" id="ii.xiv.xix-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="68.63%" prev="ii.xiv.xix" next="ii.xiv.xx" id="ii.xiv.xix.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xix.i-p1">David conquers the Philistines, the Moabites, the king of
Zobah and the Syrians, ver. 1-8. Makes the king of Hamath and the
Edomites pay tribute, ver. 9-13. His court and kingdom flourish, ver.
14-17.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="68.63%" prev="ii.xiv.xix.i" next="ii.xiv.xx.i" id="ii.xiv.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XIX" id="ii.xiv.xx-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="68.63%" prev="ii.xiv.xx" next="ii.xiv.xx.ii" id="ii.xiv.xx.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xx.i-p1">David's friendly message to king Hanun, ver. 1, 2.
Hanun's base usage of his ambassadors, ver. 3-5. The Ammonites prepare
for war, ver. 6, 7. David overthrows them and the Syrians, ver. 8-
19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="68.64%" prev="ii.xiv.xx.i" next="ii.xiv.xxi" id="ii.xiv.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xx.ii-p1">7. Chariots - Thirty two thousand men, who fought partly
from chariots, and partly on foot with chariots, or attending upon the
chariots, as the ancient manner of fighting was.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xx.ii-p2">19. His servants - Let those who have in vain stood it
out against God, be thus wise for themselves. Let them become his
servants; for they are undone, if they remain his enemies.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="68.64%" prev="ii.xiv.xx.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxi.i" id="ii.xiv.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XX" id="ii.xiv.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="68.64%" prev="ii.xiv.xxi" next="ii.xiv.xxi.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxi.i-p1">Rabbah is taken, ver. 1-3. The Philistine giants are
slain, ver. 4-8.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="68.64%" prev="ii.xiv.xxi.i" next="ii.xiv.xxii" id="ii.xiv.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxi.ii-p1">2. To weigh a talent - Or, to be worth a talent, that is,
five thousand four hundred and seventy five pounds.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxi.ii-p2">8. They fell,&amp;c. - We need not fear great men against
us, while we have the great God for us.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="68.65%" prev="ii.xiv.xxi.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxii.i" id="ii.xiv.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XXI" id="ii.xiv.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="68.65%" prev="ii.xiv.xxii" next="ii.xiv.xxii.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.i-p1">David causes Joab to number the people, ver. 1-6. He
repents, ver. 7, 8. God gives him his choice of three judgments, and he
chuses the pestilence, ver. 9-13. The havock made thereby: Jerusalem
spared, ver. 14, 15. David's prayer, ver. 16, 17. His sacrifice and
staying of the plague, ver. 18-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="68.65%" prev="ii.xiv.xxii.i" next="ii.xiv.xxiii" id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p1">1. Satan stood - Before the Lord and his tribunal to
accuse David and Israel, and to beg God's permission to tempt David.
Standing is the accusers posture before men's tribunals; and
consequently the holy scripture (which useth to speak of the things of
God, after the manner of men, to bring them down to our capacities)
elsewhere represent Satan in this posture.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p2">3. Why, &amp;c. - Or, why should this be a cause of
trespass, or an occasion of punishment to Israel? God commonly punishes
the people for the sins of their rulers, because they are for the most
part guilty of their sins in one kind or other; or at least God takes
this occasion to punish people for all their sins.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p3">6. Counted not - Partly for the following reason; and
principally by God's gracious providence to Levi, because they were
devoted to his service; and to Benjamin, because they were the least of
all the tribes, having been almost extinct, <scripRef passage="Judg. xxi. 6" id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Judg|21|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.21.6">Judg. xxi, 6</scripRef>, and because God foresaw that they would be faithful to the
house of David in the division of the tribes, and therefore he would not
have them diminished. And Joab also presumed to leave these two tribes
unnumbered, because he had specious pretenses for it; for Levi, because
they were no warriors, and the king's command reached only of those that
drew sword. And for Benjamin, because they, being so small a tribe, and
bordering upon Jerusalem, might easily be numbered afterward.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p4">7. Displeased - Because this was done without any colour
of necessity, and out of mere curiosity, and ostentation.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p5">14. There fell, &amp;c. - He was proud of the number of
his people, but God took a course to make them fewer. Justly is that we
are proud of so, taken from us, or embittered to us.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p6">16. Sackcloth - In mourning garments, humbling themselves
before God for their sins, and deprecating his wrath against the
people.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p7">18. Set up an altar, &amp;c. - The commanding of David to
build an altar, was a blessed token of reconciliation. For if God had
been pleased to kill him, he would not have commanded, because he would
not have accepted a sacrifice at his hands.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p8">20. Hid themselves - Because of the glory and majesty in
which the angel appeared, which mens weak natures are not able to bear;
and from the fear of God's vengeance which now seemed to be coming to
their family.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p9">25. Six hundred - We read, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xxiv. 24" id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p9.1" parsed="|2Sam|24|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.24.24">2 Sam. xxiv, 24</scripRef>, he gave fifty shekels of gold: that is, he gave in gold the
value of six hundred shekels of silver. 26. By fire - Hebrew. by fire
sent from heaven: which was the sign of God's acceptance. The fire that
might justly have fastened on the sinner, fastened upon the sacrifice
and consumed it. Thus Christ was made sin and a curse for us, and it
pleased the Lord to bruise him, that through him God might be to us, not
a consuming fire, but a reconciled Father.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p10">28. Sacrificed - When he perceived that his sacrifice was
acceptable to God, he proceeded to offer more sacrifices in that
place.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxii.ii-p11">30. Afraid - When he saw the angel stand with his drawn
sword over Jerusalem, he durst not go away to Gibeon, lest the angel in
the mean time should destroy Jerusalem: for the prevention whereof he
thought it proper to worship God in that place, which he had consecrated
by his special presence and acceptance.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="68.71%" prev="ii.xiv.xxii.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxiii.i" id="ii.xiv.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XXII" id="ii.xiv.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="68.71%" prev="ii.xiv.xxiii" next="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiii.i-p1">David prepares for building the temple, ver. 1-5.
Instructs Solomon concerning the work, ver. 6-16. Commands the princes
to assist him therein, ver. 17-19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXII" progress="68.71%" prev="ii.xiv.xxiii.i" next="ii.xiv.xxiv" id="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii-p1">1. Said - Thro' the instinct and direction of God's
spirit, by which as he is said to have had the pattern of the house,
porch, altar, &amp;c. chap. xxviii, 11, 12, 19, so doubtless he was
instructed as to the place where the house should be built. This - This
is the place appointed by God for the building of his temple and
altar.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii-p2">5. Prepared, &amp;c. - And good reason, because it was
intended for the honour of the great God, and was to be a type of
Christ, in whom all fulness dwells, and in whom are hid all
treasures.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii-p3">8. Shed blood - Not that wars are simply unlawful, but to
teach us that the church (whereof the temple was an illustrious type)
should be built by Christ, the prince of peace, <scripRef passage="Isaiah ix. 6" id="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Isa|9|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.9.6">Isaiah ix, 6</scripRef>, and that it should be gathered and built up, not by might
or power but by God's spirit, <scripRef passage="Zech iv. 6" id="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii-p3.2" parsed="|Zech|4|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Zech.4.6">Zech iv, 6</scripRef>, and by the preaching the Gospel of peace. David therefore
was less fit for that service, than one who had not been called to such
bloody work. Likewise by setting him aside for this reason, God shewed
how precious human life is to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii-p4">14. Trouble - This he alleges as a reason why he could do
no more, because of the many wars, whereby much of his treasures were
exhausted. Talents - A talent of Gold in the first constitution was
three thousand shekels, as may be gathered from <scripRef passage="Exod. xxxviii. 24, 25, 26" id="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Exod|38|24|38|26" osisRef="Bible:Exod.38.24-Exod.38.26">Exod.
xxxviii, 24, 25, 26</scripRef>, and so this amounts to a vast sum, yet not impossible for
David to get, considering how many and great conquests he made, and what
vast spoils and presents he got; and that he endeavoured by all
honourable ways to get as much as he could, out of zeal for God's house.
And whereas some object, that this quantity of gold and silver was
sufficient, tho' the whole fabrick of the temple had consisted of massy
gold and silver, it is to be considered, that all this treasure was not
spent upon the materials of the temple, but a great part of it upon the
workmen, who were nigh two hundred thousand, whereof a great number were
officers, and what was not employed in the building of the temple, was
laid up in the sacred treasures.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii-p5">16. Be doing - When thou shalt come to the throne. The
sense of God's presence must not slacken our endeavours; because he is
with us, we must rise and be doing. Then he will be with us even to the
end. Work out your salvation, and God will work in you.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="68.75%" prev="ii.xiv.xxiii.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxiv.i" id="ii.xiv.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XXIII" id="ii.xiv.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxiv-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="68.75%" prev="ii.xiv.xxiv" next="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.i-p1">David declares Solomon his successor, ver. 1. Numbers the
Levites and appoints them their several offices, ver. 2-5. Takes an
account of the families of the Levites, ver. 6-23. Reckons them from
twenty years old, and appoints them their work, ver. 24-32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="68.76%" prev="ii.xiv.xxiv.i" next="ii.xiv.xxv" id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p1">2. Gathered, &amp;c. - To declare God's mind and his own
will, that Solomon should be his successor: and to acquaint them with
those directions which he had received from God by the spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p2">3. Upwards - Not only 'till fifty, as it was appointed, <scripRef passage="Num. iv. 2, 3" id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Num|4|2|4|3" osisRef="Bible:Num.4.2-Num.4.3">Num. iv, 2,
3</scripRef>, but even 'till their death: for that was but a temporary
law grounded upon a special reason, because the Levites were employed in
carrying the tabernacle and sacred vessels from place to place; and
therefore God would have them freed from those burdens when they came to
feel the infirmities of age: which reason wholly ceasing upon the
building of the temple, their work being far easier than it had been,
and their service being more a privilege than a burden, their time of
service is justly prolonged.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p3">4. Officers - To take care that all the work of the
temple about sacrifices should be punctually performed, either by
themselves or others: which they were not to do all at once, but by
courses, a thousand at a time. Judges - Not in the affairs of the
temple; there the priests presided; but in several parts of the kingdom,
where they assisted the princes and elders of every tribe, in the
administration of justice.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p4">13. Sanctify - That he might keep them from pollution:
for these most holy things were polluted when they were touched by any
other person. He and his - Not only his eldest sons the high-priests
successively, but all his posterity or all the priests; for the works
here following were not peculiar to the high-priest, but common to all
the priests.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p5">14. Levi - They were accounted only as common Levites,
and were not priests: which is mentioned for the honour of Moses, and
the demonstration of his eminent piety and self-denial, who willingly
left the government to Joshua, and the priesthood to Aaron, and was
content to have his posterity reduced to a private and mean
condition.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p6">24. Twenty years - As the Levites were anciently numbered
from two several times, from the twenty fifth year of their age, and
from the thirtieth, <scripRef passage="Num. iv. 3" id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Num|4|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.4.3">Num. iv, 3</scripRef>; viii, 24. In like manner they are here numbered both from
their twentieth year, when they were solemnly prepared for, and
instructed, and by degrees exercised in some parts of their work; and
from their thirtieth year, when they were admitted to the full exercise
of their office. And the reason why they were now sooner admitted to
service than they had been formerly, is given in the next verses because
now their work was more easy, being wholly discharged from that
burdensome work of carrying the tabernacle. Besides the people of Israel
were multiplied: therefore more hands were necessary, that every
Israelite who brought an offering, might find a Levite ready to assist
him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p7">28. Holy things - Holy places, and garments, and vessels,
and sacrifices, which were to be washed and cleansed from any filthiness
that might cleave to them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p8">29. All measure - All measures used either in sacred or
civil things, the publick standards whereof were kept in the temple; and
therefore the care of keeping them inviolable and producing them upon
occasion, musts needs belong to the priests, and under them to the
Levites, who were to examine other measures and all things by them, as
occasion required; that so the priests might be at leisure for their
higher and greater employments.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p9">30. Morning and even - The two solemn times of offering
sacrifices: which work was attended with publick prayer and
thanksgiving.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii-p10">32. Charge - What the priests should commit to their
charge, or command them to do.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="68.82%" prev="ii.xiv.xxiv.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxv.i" id="ii.xiv.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XXIV" id="ii.xiv.xxv-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIV" progress="68.82%" prev="ii.xiv.xxv" next="ii.xiv.xxv.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxv.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxv.i-p1">The distribution of the priests, ver. 1-19. Of the
Levites, ver. 20-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIV" progress="68.82%" prev="ii.xiv.xxv.i" next="ii.xiv.xxvi" id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii-p1">1. Divisions - The several branches into which that
family was divided.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii-p2">2. Therefore, &amp;c. - Were the only persons to whom the
execution of that office was committed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii-p3">3. Distributed - Allotting to each of them several times,
wherein they should by turns have the government of holy
ministrations.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii-p4">5. By lot - That the disposal thereof might be of the
Lord, and so all contention be prevented, as no man could be charged
with partiality, nor could any say, they had wrong done them. In like
manner Matthias was chosen to the apostleship by lot with prayer. "And I
know not, says Mr. Henry, but it might be still used in faith, in
parallel cases, as an instituted ordinance." Of God - Or rather, of the
things of God, that is, of all persons ministering in the sanctuary, and
of all holy ministrations done in it, and of all other matters of the
Lord, as they are called by way of distinction from, the king's matters,
<scripRef passage="2 Chron. xix. 11" id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|2Chr|19|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.19.11">2 Chron. xix, 11</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii-p5">6. One, &amp;c. - Or, the chief of one house of the
fathers was taken (by lot) for Eleazar (out of his family) and that
which was taken after it was taken for Ithamar, out of his family. So
the first lot fell to Eleazar, and the second to Ithamar, the third to
Eleazar, and the fourth to Ithamar, so successively, 'till all the
families of Ithamar had received their lots. And afterwards all the lots
came forth to the rest of Eleazar's families, which were double in
number to those of Ithamar.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii-p6">7. Came - Out of the vessel in which all the lots were
put together, and out of which they were severally taken.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii-p7">19. These, &amp;c. - In this order and method they were
to come to perform the offices of the temple. To come - To come into the
temple every sabbath-day, and to continue there 'till the next sabbath,
when they were relieved by others. Aaron - Under the direction of the
high-priests, whom he calls Aaron, because he represented his person and
executed his office, and their father, because of the authority which by
God's appointment he had over them.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxv.ii-p8">31. Over against - Answerable for number and order to
those of the priests, so that there should be a course of the Levites
for each course of the priests.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="68.86%" prev="ii.xiv.xxv.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxvi.i" id="ii.xiv.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XXV" id="ii.xiv.xxvi-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.25" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxvi-p0.2">XXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXV" progress="68.86%" prev="ii.xiv.xxvi" next="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxvi.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvi.i-p1">The person's that were to be employed in singing, ver.
1-7. The order in which they were to attend determined by lot, ver. 8-
31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXV" progress="68.86%" prev="ii.xiv.xxvi.i" next="ii.xiv.xxvii" id="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii-p1">1. And captains - All the princes of Israel, with the
priests and the Levites, whom David gathered together, chap. xxiii, 2,
for this very end, that with their approbation and consent, all these
things might be established; who are here fitly called the captains of
the host; for the princes were, under David, the chief captains of the
militia of the kingdom; and as the Levites are called an host, and the
Lord's host, because of their number and order in holy ministrations; so
these priests and Levites were the captains and governors of the rest.
Separated - Distributed them into their several ranks: which, tho'
chiefly done by David as a prophet, and by Divine direction, yet is
imputed in part to the captains of the host, because it was done with
their concurrence and approbation. The service - To the service of God
under the conduct of these persons. Prophecy - Praise God by singing the
psalms of David, and other sacred songs made by themselves, who were
prophets, or by other prophets or holy men of God. Workmen - Of the
persons employed in this sacred work. This good work it seems Samuel
revived, but did not live to bring it to perfection. Let each in his day
do what he can for God, tho' he cannot carry it so far as he would. When
we are gone, God can raise up others to build on our foundation, and
bring forth the top-stone.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii-p2">2. Of Asaph - Under his direction. Of the king - In such
manner and order as David appointed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii-p3">3. Six - Jeduthun their father being included in that
number: or Shimei, mentioned ver. 17.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii-p4">5. The king's seer - He is called the king's seer, either
because the king took special delight in him; or because he frequently
attended the king in his palace, executing his sacred office there,
while the rest were employed in the tabernacle. In the words - To sing
Divine songs as were inspired by God to the prophets or holy men of God.
The horn - To praise God with the sound of a trumpet or some other
musical instrument made of horn, which being a martial kind of music,
might be most grateful to David's martial spirit: tho' he was also
skilled in other instruments of music which he used in the house of
God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii-p5">7. Cunning - Who were so skilful that they were able to
teach others; and together with their scholars, made up the four
thousand mentioned chap. xxiii, 5.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii-p6">8. Ward - A course of Levites answerable to one of the
priests, upon whom the Levites were to wait in their holy ministrations,
chap. xxiii, 28. The scholar - Without any respect to their different
ages or abilities.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii-p7">9. To Joseph - For the family of Asaph, of which Joseph
was. Here that clause, he, his sons, and his brethren were twelve, is to
be understood, as it is expressed in all the following verses, otherwise
they do not make up that number of two hundred and eighty-eight
mentioned ver. 7.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="68.91%" prev="ii.xiv.xxvi.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxvii.i" id="ii.xiv.xxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XXVI" id="ii.xiv.xxvii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.26" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxvii-p0.2">XXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVI" progress="68.91%" prev="ii.xiv.xxvii" next="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxvii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.i-p1">The Levites that were appointed to be porters, ver. 1-19.
Those that were appointed to be treasurers and store-keepers, ver.
20-28. Those that were officers and Judg. in the country, ver. 29-
32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVI" progress="68.92%" prev="ii.xiv.xxvii.i" next="ii.xiv.xxviii" id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p1">5. Blessed him - With a numerous posterity and other
blessings, for his respect and affection to the ark. The increase and
building up of families, is owing to the Divine blessing. And a great
blessing it is to have many children, when they are like these, eminent
in the service of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p2">6. Of valour - This clause is divers times mentioned,
because their office required both strength and courage: for they were
to shut the doors of the temple, one whereof was so great and weighty,
that in the second temple it required twenty men to open and shut it.
They were also to keep the guard, to keep out all unclean or forbidden
persons, to prevent or suppress any tumults or disorders which might
happen in the temple or in its courts, to keep the treasures of the
temple, ver. 20, 22, 24, 26, to be officers and Judges over Israel, ver.
29, and to manage every matter pertaining to God, and the affairs of the
king, ver. 32.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p3">10. Made him the chief - Not in inheriting the estate;
(this was forbidden by the law) but in this service, for which he was
better qualified than his elder brother.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p4">12. Wards - Hebrew. having wards answerably to their
brethren the other Levites, who were divided into twenty-four courses,
as the priests also and the porters were.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p5">13. Cast lots - Determining the times and places of their
service not by age or dignity, but merely by lot. Every gate - That it
might be known to whom the care of each gate was more especially
committed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p6">15. Asuppim - Or, of gatherings, probably so named from
the assembly of the elders, who met there to consult about the affairs
of the temple.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p7">16. Shallecheth - A gate of the court so called, as some
think, because the ashes and filth of the temple were cast out on that
side, which was the most convenient for that purpose, because that was a
private quarter, the great ways to the temple lying on the other sides.
Going up - By which causeway they went up towards the temple. Ward
against ward - As one gate was over against another, the west against
the east, and the north against the south, so one ward was over against
another.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p8">17. Six - For that being the chief gate of the temple
required a better guard.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p9">20. Treasures - There seem to be two different kinds of
treasures, the former containing the sacred vessels and other treasures,
which by God's command were appropriated to the maintenance of the
house; the latter only those things which had been freely given or
dedicated to God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p10">23. The Amramites - The persons following were of these,
or the most of these families. Only here is none of the family of the
Uzzielites; either because that family was now extinct, whence it is
that we read no more of them in the scripture, but only in this place,
and <scripRef passage="Num. iii. 27" id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Num|3|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.3.27">Num. iii, 27</scripRef>, or because there was none of them fit to be employed and
trusted in these matters.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p11">24. Ruler - The chief over all the treasures, mentioned
before or afterward, as his title shews, which is peculiarly given to
him and to none of the rest.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p12">27. Maintain - Or repair it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p13">29. Judges - Judges over the people, in the several
cities and towns, to determine questions and controversies which might
arise among them. And the reason why the Levites were intrusted with
these matters was, because the common law of Israel, by which they had
and held all their rights was no other than the law of God, whereof the
priests and Levites being the established interpreters, must needs be
the most proper Judges of things depending thereon.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p14">30. Of the Lord - In all things which concerned the house
or worship of God; to take care that such monies as were given towards
building the temple, or towards the sacrifices and other holy
ministrations should be gathered and received, and faithfully sent up to
Jerusalem; and to see to the execution of all the laws of God among the
people. Service of, &amp;c. - They served the king in the execution of
his decrees, by which the several rights of the king and people were
established. And as the king was the principal person intrusted with the
execution of God's laws, so these Levites chiefly were his eyes by which
he saw his people's transgressions, and his hands by which he inflicted
due censures upon them for their miscarriages.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii-p15">31. Fortieth year - His last year, in which he made all
the orders of families and officers recorded in these chapters. We
should be so much the more diligent in doing good, as we see the day
approaching. If we live not to enjoy the fruit of our labours, let us
not grudge it to them that come after us.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="69.00%" prev="ii.xiv.xxvii.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxviii.i" id="ii.xiv.xxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XXVII" id="ii.xiv.xxviii-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.27" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxviii-p0.2">XXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVII" progress="69.00%" prev="ii.xiv.xxviii" next="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxviii.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.i-p1">The captains for every month of the year, ver. 1-15. The
princes of the several tribes, ver. 16-24. The officers of the court,
ver. 25-34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVII" progress="69.00%" prev="ii.xiv.xxviii.i" next="ii.xiv.xxix" id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p1">1. Officers - The standing militia of Israel as it was
settled under their several officers. Of courses - In all the business
wherein the king had occasion for these persons who were to attend him
by turns. Came in, &amp;c. - who being armed and mustered, and to wait
upon the king, at Jerusalem or other places, as the king should see fit.
By this order near three hundred thousand of his people were instructed
and exercised in the use of their arms, and fitted for the defense of
their king and kingdom when it should be needful, and in the mean time
sufficient provision was made against any sudden tumults or irruptions
of enemies. And this monthly course was contrived that the burden of it
might be easy and equally distributed among the people.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p2">16. The ruler - These were the princes of the tribes, the
constant rulers of the tribes; who seem to have had a superior power to
these twenty four captains, and therefore are named before them, being
probably the king's chief counsellors and assistants in the great
affairs of his kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p3">22. Tribes - Of the most of the tribes, not of all: for
Gad is omitted, probably because that tribe was joined with the
Reubenites under one prince.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p4">23. Because - And therefore to number them all both above
and under twenty years old, had been both an infinite trouble and a
tempting of God, or a questioning the truth of his promises.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p5">27. Vineyards - Over the workmen and labourers in the
vineyards; as the next officer is over the fruit of the vineyards. In
like manner, one man was over the labourers in the fields, ver. 26, and
another over the fruits of the fields put into stores.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p6">31. All these - It is observable, here are no officers
for state, none for sport, no master of the ceremonies, or of the
bounds, but all for substance, agreeable to the simplicity and plainness
of those times. David was a great soldier, a great scholar, and a great
prince; and yet a great husband of his estate. Those magistrates who
would have their subjects industrious, must themselves be examples of
application to business.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p7">32. A scribe - Either one learned in the laws of God,
which were also the laws of the land, or, the king's secretary. King's
sons - As their tutor or governour.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p8">33. Counsellor - The person whose counsel in matters of
state the king most prized and followed. Companion - Or his friend, <scripRef passage="2 Sam. xv. 37" id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|2Sam|15|37|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Sam.15.37">2 Sam.
xv, 37</scripRef>, the person whom he trusted with his secrets, and whose
conversation was most pleasant and acceptable to him. Observe, A cunning
man was his counsellor: but an honest man was his friend.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii-p9">34. After Ahithophel - After his death, these were his
chief counsellors.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVIII" progress="69.05%" prev="ii.xiv.xxviii.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxix.i" id="ii.xiv.xxix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XXVIII" id="ii.xiv.xxix-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|28|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.28" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxix-p0.2">XXVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVIII" progress="69.05%" prev="ii.xiv.xxix" next="ii.xiv.xxix.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxix.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.i-p1">David declares to the general assembly, that God had
appointed Solomon to succeed him and to build the temple, ver. 1- 7.
Exhorts the people and Solomon, to cleave to God, ver. 8-10. Delivers to
him the model and materials for the temple, ver. 11- 19. Encourages him
to begin and finish the work, ver. 20, 21.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVIII" progress="69.05%" prev="ii.xiv.xxix.i" next="ii.xiv.xxx" id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p1">1. And David assembled, &amp;c. - A great deal of
business David had done in his day. And the nearer he comes to his end,
the more busy he is, still endeavouring to do his work with all his
might. He is now recovered from the weakness mentioned <scripRef passage="1 Kings i. 1" id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p1.1" parsed="|1Kgs|1|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.1.1">1 Kings i, 1</scripRef>. He therefore improves his recovery, as giving him an
opportunity of doing God and his country a little more service.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p2">2. Stood - Out of reverence to God and respect to this
great and honourable assembly. Brethren - So he calls the princes and
chief rulers, both because they had a share with him, though under him
in the government; and in compliance with the Divine command, that the
king should not be lifted up above his brethren; <scripRef passage="Deut. xvii. 20" id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Deut|17|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.17.20">Deut.
xvii, 20</scripRef>. Of rest - A place where it might be fixed, and no more
removed from place to place, as it had been. Foot-stool - An house for
the ark is here styled an house for the foot-stool of our God. Heaven is
his throne: the earth and the most magnificent temples thereon are but
his foot-stool. So much difference is there between the manifestations
of his glory, in the upper and in the lower world!</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p3">6. My house, &amp;c. - So was he a figure of him that was
to come, who is both the founder and the foundation of the
gospel-temple.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p4">7. At this day - As he hath begun. This promise is
absolute with regard to the Messiah, but conditional, with regard to
Solomon. If we are constant in our duty, then and not otherwise, we may
expect the continuance of his favour.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p5">8. Of our God - I exhort and charge you every one,
calling God who is here present, and this congregation wherein all
Israel are present by their representatives, or witness against you, if
you do not follow my counsel. Keep and seek - Keep those commands which
you know, and seek for, or search into what you are yet ignorant of,
that you may distinctly understand the whole will of God, and seriously
give yourselves to the practice of it. God's commandments cannot be kept
without great care.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p6">9. Know - So as to love and serve him. Words of knowledge
in scripture-use commonly imply affection and practice. Or, acknowledge
him, as thy God, by loving and obeying him. Searcheth - If thou dost
only put on a profession of religion to please me, or if thy obedience
to God be unsincere, thou mayest indeed deceive me, but thou canst not
deceive him, for he searcheth the motions of thy heart. Cast thee off -
Notwithstanding all his promises to me and to my seed, and that great
honour and favour which he hath shewed thee.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p7">10. The sanctuary - For the ark to dwell in. Be strong -
Take courage to break through all difficulties. Without this, we can do
no work of God as we ought.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p8">11. The porch - Of the temple. The houses - The houses of
the temple, namely, the holy place, and the holy of holies. Parlors -
Those rooms which were made against the wall of the house round about, <scripRef passage="1 Kings vi. 5" id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p8.1" parsed="|1Kgs|6|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.6.5">1 Kings vi, 5</scripRef>. The place - In what particular part of the holy of holies
it was to be placed.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p9">12. By the spirit - All the particulars of the tabernacle
built by Moses were suggested to him by God's spirit, and it is not
credible that God would use less care and exactness in the building of
this far more glorious and durable work. All this, it seems, was given
him in writing, probably by the ministry of an angel. The temple was to
be a sacred thing, a type of Christ, of his church, and of heaven.
Therefore it was not to be contrived by man's invention, but to be
framed by divine institution. So Christ, the true temple, the church,
the gospel-temple, and heaven, the everlasting temple, are all framed
according to the divine counsels, and the plan laid before the world
began. It is supposed, the tabernacle of Moses, with all its utensils,
being wanted no more, was laid up here.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p10">15. According, &amp;c. - Whether they were fixed in one
place, whereof there were ten in the holy place, or to be carried from
place to place.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p11">16. The tables - There were divers tables to be used
about the shew-bread; but one of them seems to have been of more
eminency than the rest, and therefore it is commonly called the table of
the shew-bread in the singular number.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p12">18. Refined gold - Purer than any of the rest. For that
was typical of the intercession of Christ, than which nothing can be
more pure and perfect. The cherubim - Which Solomon was to make, (for
those which were fastened to the mercy-seat were made by Moses long
before) which he fitly compares to a chariot, because within them God is
said to sit and to dwell. And because a chariot is made to carry a
person from place to place, this expression may be used to intimate that
God was not so fixed to them by the building of this temple, but that he
would remove from them if they forsook him. Covered - Not above it, for
that was done by Moses's cherubim, but before it, to keep it from the
eyes of the high-priest, when he entered into the most holy place.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p13">19. In writing - God revealed this to some man of God,
who put it into writing, and by him to David. Or, God did, as it were,
by his own hand, (where-with he wrote the Ten Commandments) write these
things upon the table of his mind.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxix.ii-p14">20. My God - Whom I have chosen and served, who has all
along been with me and prospered me, I recommend thee to him; he will be
with thee, to strengthen, direct and prosper thee. The God that owned
our fathers, and carried them thro' the services of their day, will, in
like manner, if we are faithful to him, go along with us in our day, and
will never fail us. God never leaves any, unless they first leave
him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIX" progress="69.15%" prev="ii.xiv.xxix.ii" next="ii.xiv.xxx.i" id="ii.xiv.xxx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="1 Chron. XXIX" id="ii.xiv.xxx-p0.1" parsed="|1Chr|29|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.29" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xiv.xxx-p0.2">XXIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIX" progress="69.15%" prev="ii.xiv.xxx" next="ii.xiv.xxx.ii" id="ii.xiv.xxx.i">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.i-p1">David exhorts them to contribute toward building and
furnishing the temple, ver. 1-5. They do contribute accordingly, ver.
6-9. He offers up solemn prayers, praises and sacrifices to God, ver.
10-21. Solomon is enthroned, ver. 22-25. David finishes his course, ver.
26-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIX" progress="69.15%" prev="ii.xiv.xxx.i" next="ii.xv" id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii">

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p1">2. My might - Work for God must be done with all our
might, or we shall bring nothing to pass in it.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p2">4. Of Ophir - The best and purest gold. The walls - The
walls of the temple with God, and of the rooms adjoining to it, with
silver beaten out into plates.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p3">5. To consecrate - To offer an offering, as I have done.
Hebrew. To fill his hand unto the Lord. They that engage themselves in
the service of God, will have their hands full: there is work enough for
the whole man in that service.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p4">9. Rejoiced - Because this was both an effect of God's
grace in them, an eminent token of God's favour to them, and a pledge
that this long-desired work, would receive a certain and speedy
accomplishment. Great joy - To see the work, which his heart was so much
set upon, likely to go on. It is a great reviving to good men when they
are leaving the world, to see those they leave behind zealous for the
work of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p5">10. Blessed, &amp;c. - David was now full of days, and
near his end, and it well becomes the aged children of God, to have
their hearts much enlarged in praise and thanksgiving. The nearer we
come to the land of everlasting praise, the more we should speak the
language, and do the work of that world.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p6">14. To offer - That thou shouldest give us both riches to
make such an offering, and a willing heart to offer them, both which are
the gifts and the fruits of thy good grace and mercy to us. Of thine -
We return only what we have received, and therefore only pay a debt to
thee. The more we do for God, the more we are indebted to him; for the
honour of being employed in his service, and for grace enabling us in
any measure to serve him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p7">15. Strangers - For the land which we possess is thine,
not ours; we are not the proprietors but only thy tenants: and as our
fathers once were mere strangers in it, even before men, so we at this
day are no better before thee, having no absolute right in it, but only
to travel through it, and sojourn in it for the short time that we live
in the world. None abiding - We only give thee what we must shortly
leave, and what we cannot keep to ourselves: and therefore it is a great
favour that thou wilt accept such offerings. David's days had as much of
substance in them as most men: for he was upon the whole a good man, an
useful man, and now an old man. And yet he puts himself in the front of
those who must acknowledge, that their days on the earth are as a
shadow: which speaks of our life as a vain life, a dark life, a
transient life, and a life that will have its period, either in perfect
light or perfect darkness.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p8">16. All thine own - In like manner we ought to
acknowledge God in all spiritual things: referring every good thought,
good desire, and good work to his grace.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p9">18. Of Abraham, &amp;c. - A God in covenant with them,
and with us for their sakes. Keep forever - Since it is from thy grace
that thy people have such willing minds, continue that grace to them,
that they may persist in the same generous disposition towards thee and
thy worship. Prepare - Or, rather, confirm, thou who hast begun a good
work, confirm and carry it on by thy grace.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p10">20. Worshipped - The Lord with religious, and the king
with civil worship.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p11">22. The second time - The first time, was when he was
made king during Adonijah's conspiracy. And Zadok - It must be
remembered that the high-priest had his viceregent who might officiate
in his stead. So that this action of theirs, the anointing Zadok, did
not, actually constitute him high-priest, but only settled the reversion
of it upon him and his line after Abiathar's death; even as David's
making Solomon king, and their anointing Solomon to be the chief
governor here, did not put him into actual possession of the kingdom,
but only gave him a right to it after the present king's death: hence,
notwithstanding this anointing, Abiathar continued to exercise his
office 'till Solomon thrust him out, <scripRef passage="1 Kings ii. 27" id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p11.1" parsed="|1Kgs|2|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.2.27">1 Kings ii, 27</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p12">24. Of the Lord - On the throne of Israel, which is
called the throne of the Lord, because the Lord himself was in a
peculiar manner the king and governor of Israel. He had the founding, he
had the filling of their throne, by immediate direction.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p13">26. Thus, &amp;c. - This sacred writer having mentioned
the anointing of Solomon and upon that occasion proceeded to give a
farther account of Solomon's actual settlement in his kingdom, returns
to his main business, to give an account of the close of David's reign
and life. He here brings him to the end of his day, leaves him asleep,
and draws the curtains about him.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p14">28. Riches and honour - That is, he had enough of this
world, and of the riches of and honour of it; and he knew when he had
enough. He was satisfied with it, and very willing to go to a better
place.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p15">29. The book - In the chronicles of the kingdom, which
were written by Nathan and Gad, who were not only prophets, but
historiographers out of which either they or some other prophets took by
the direction of God's spirit such passages, as were most important and
useful for the church in succeeding ages.</p>

<p id="ii.xiv.xxx.ii-p16">30. The times - The changes which befel him; both his
troubles, and his successes, the word time or times being often put for
things done or happening in them. The countries - Bordering upon the
land of Canaan.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE SECOND BOOK OF CHRONICLES" progress="69.25%" prev="ii.xiv.xxx.ii" next="ii.xv.i" id="ii.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2Chr" id="ii.xv-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.xv-p0.2">NOTES ON THE SECOND BOOK OF CHRONICLES</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Second Chronicles" progress="69.25%" prev="ii.xv" next="ii.xv.ii" id="ii.xv.i">

<p id="ii.xv.i-p1">THIS book begins with the reign of Solomon, continues the
history of the kings of Judah to the captivity, and concludes with the
fall of that illustrious monarchy and the destruction of the temple.
That monarchy, as it was prior in time, so it was in dignity to the four
which Nebuchadnezzar dreamed of. The Babylonian began in Nebuchadnezzar
himself, and lasted about seventy years: the Persian monarchy, in
several families, about an hundred and thirty: the Grecian, in its
several branches, about three hundred: and three hundred more went far
with the Roman. Whereas the monarchy of Judah continued considerable in
a lineal descent, between four and five hundred years. We had the story
of the house of David before intermixt with that of the kings of Israel:
but here we have its entire, much is repeated here which we had before:
yet many passages are enlarged on, and divers added which we had not
before, especially relating to religion: the reign of Solomon we have,
chap. 1-9. That of Rehoboam, chap. 10-12. The short reign of Ahijah,
chap. 13. The long rein of Asa, chap. 14-16. The reign of Jehoshaphat,
chap. 17-20. Of Jehoram and Ahaziah, chap. 21, 22. Of Joash and Amaziah,
chap. 23-25. Of Uzziah, chap. 26. Of Jotham, chap. 27. Of Ahaz, chap.
28. Of Hezekiah, chap. 29-32. Of Manasseh and Amon, chap. 33. Of Josiah,
chap. 34, 35. Of his sons, chap. 36.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="69.27%" prev="ii.xv.i" next="ii.xv.ii.i" id="ii.xv.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. I" id="ii.xv.ii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="69.27%" prev="ii.xv.ii" next="ii.xv.ii.ii" id="ii.xv.ii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.ii.i-p1">Solomon's sacrifices, ver. 1-6. His prayer and God's
answer, ver. 7-12.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.ii.i-p2">The strength, wealth, and trade of Israel, ver.
13-17.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="69.27%" prev="ii.xv.ii.i" next="ii.xv.iii" id="ii.xv.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.ii.ii-p1">2. Spake - Concerning his intention of going to Gibeon,
and that they should attend him thither.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.ii.ii-p2">4. The ark - He separated the ark from the tabernacle,
and brought it to Jerusalem, where he intended to build a more noble and
lasting habitation for it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.ii.ii-p3">5. Sought - Sought the Lord and his favour by hearty
prayers and sacrifices in the place which God had appointed.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.ii.ii-p4">8. To reign, &amp;c. - Give me the spirit of my father
David, that Israel may not suffer by the change. The eminency of those
that went before us, and the obligation that lies upon us, to keep and
carry on the good work they were engaged in, should quicken our prayers
for wisdom and grace, that we may do the work of God in our day, as
faithful as they did in theirs.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.ii.ii-p5">12. Neither &amp;c. - Those that make this world their
end, come short of the other, and frequently of this too. But those who
make the other world their end, shall not only obtain that, but shalt
have as much as is convenient of this world in their way.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="69.29%" prev="ii.xv.ii.ii" next="ii.xv.iii.i" id="ii.xv.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. II" id="ii.xv.iii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="69.29%" prev="ii.xv.iii" next="ii.xv.iii.ii" id="ii.xv.iii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.iii.i-p1">Solomon appoints men to build the temple and his own
house, ver. 1-2. His message to Huram, ver. 3-10. Huram's obliging
answer, ver. 11-16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="69.29%" prev="ii.xv.iii.i" next="ii.xv.iv" id="ii.xv.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.iii.ii-p1">1. His kingdom - A royal palace for himself and his
successors.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iii.ii-p2">5. Great - For though the temple strictly so called, was
but small, yet the buildings belonging to it, were large and
numerous.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iii.ii-p3">6. Contain - When I speak of building an house for our
great God, let none think I mean to comprehend God within it, for he is
infinite. To sacrifice - To worship him there where he is graciously
present.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iii.ii-p4">12. Made heaven and earth - It seems Huram was not only a
friend to the Jewish nation, but a proselyte to their religion, and that
he worshipped Jehovah, the God of Israel, (who was now known by that
name to the neighbour-nations) as the God that made heaven and earth,
and the fountain of power as well as of being.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iii.ii-p5">14. Of Daniel, &amp;c. - A good omen of uniting Jew and
Gentile in the gospel-temple.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iii.ii-p6">17. The strangers - For David had not only numbered his
own people, but afterward the strangers, that Solomon might have a true
account of them, and employ them about his buildings. Yet Solomon
numbered them again, because death might have made a considerable
alteration among them since David's numbering.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iii.ii-p7">18. Hewers in the mountains - He would not employ the
free-born Israelites in this drudgery, but the strangers that were
proselytes, who having no lands, applied themselves to trades, and got
their living by their industry or ingenuity.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="69.32%" prev="ii.xv.iii.ii" next="ii.xv.iv.i" id="ii.xv.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. III" id="ii.xv.iv-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="69.32%" prev="ii.xv.iv" next="ii.xv.iv.ii" id="ii.xv.iv.i">

<p id="ii.xv.iv.i-p1">The place and time of his building the temple, ver. 1, 2.
The dimension and ornaments of it, ver. 3-9. The cherubim in the most
holy place, ver. 10-13. The veil, ver. 14. The two pillars, ver. 15-
17.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="69.32%" prev="ii.xv.iv.i" next="ii.xv.v" id="ii.xv.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.iv.ii-p1">1. Moriah - It was the belief of the ancient Jews, that
the temple was built on that very place, where Abraham offered up
Issac.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iv.ii-p2">3. Instructed - By David, and by the Spirit of God. The
measure - According to the measure which was first fixed.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iv.ii-p3">4. The height - This being a kind of turret to the
building.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iv.ii-p4">5. Greater house - The holy place, which was thrice as
large as the holy of holies.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iv.ii-p5">9. Nails - Each of the nails, screws, or pins, by which
the golden plates were fastened to the walls, weighed, or rather was
worth, fifty shekels, workmanship and all. Upper chambers - Rather, the
roof.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iv.ii-p6">10. Image work - Or, of moveable work, not fixed to the
mercy- seat, as the Mosaical cherubim, but in a moving posture. It
seems, they were designed to represent the angels, who attend the Divine
Majesty.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iv.ii-p7">13. Inward - Hebrew. towards the house, that is, the most
holy house.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iv.ii-p8">14. The veil - The inner veil before the most holy place.
This denoted the darkness of that dispensation and the distance at which
the worshippers were kept. But at the death of Christ this veil was
rent; for thro' him we are brought nigh, and have boldness, or liberty,
not only to look, but to enter into the holiest.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.iv.ii-p9">17. Jachin - That is, He shall establish. Boaz - That is,
In it is strength.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="69.34%" prev="ii.xv.iv.ii" next="ii.xv.v.i" id="ii.xv.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. IV" id="ii.xv.v-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="69.34%" prev="ii.xv.v" next="ii.xv.v.ii" id="ii.xv.v.i">

<p id="ii.xv.v.i-p1">The brazen altar, sea and lavers, ver. 1-5. The golden
candlesticks and tables, ver. 7, 8. The doors overlaid with brass, the
vessels of the altar, and other brass work, ver. 9-18. The golden altar
of incense with its appurtenances, ver. 19-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="69.35%" prev="ii.xv.v.i" next="ii.xv.vi" id="ii.xv.v.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.v.ii-p1">7. Their form - The old form which God prescribed to
Moses.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.v.ii-p2">8. Ten tables - Whereon the shew-bread was set, ver. 19.
Perhaps each of these had twelve loaves on it. As the house was
enlarged, so was the provision.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.v.ii-p3">16. His father - He is so called because Solomon usually
called him by that name out of that great respect which he bare to him
for his excellent art and service which he did for him: it being usual
to call great artists and inventors of things by this name.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.v.ii-p4">20. The manner - According to the prescription of God to
Moses.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.v.ii-p5">22. Of gold - In part; they were made of wood, but
covered with golden plates.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="69.36%" prev="ii.xv.v.ii" next="ii.xv.vi.i" id="ii.xv.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. V" id="ii.xv.vi-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="69.36%" prev="ii.xv.vi" next="ii.xv.vi.ii" id="ii.xv.vi.i">

<p id="ii.xv.vi.i-p1">Solomon brings the dedicated treasures into the house,
and the ark into the sanctuary, ver. 1-10. While the priests and Levites
sing praise, the glory of God fills the house, ver. 11-14.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="69.36%" prev="ii.xv.vi.i" next="ii.xv.vii" id="ii.xv.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.vi.ii-p1">1. The gold - The remainder of those vast sums mentioned,
<scripRef passage="1 Chron. xxii. 14" id="ii.xv.vi.ii-p1.1" parsed="|1Chr|22|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.22.14">1
Chron. xxii, 14</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.vi.ii-p2">5. The ark - The ark was a type of Christ, and a token of
the presence of God. That gracious promise, Lo, I am with you always,
even unto the end of the world, does in effect bring the ark into our
religious assemblies, if we claim it by faith and prayer. And this we
should be earnest for: the temple itself, if Christ leave it, is a
desolate place. Those &amp;c. - As many of them as were fit for use, it
is probable, were still used. The rest were carefully laid up, as
monuments of antiquity.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.vi.ii-p3">9. To this day - When this history was first written; not
when it was reviewed by Ezra: for after the return from Babylon, neither
staves nor ark were any more seen.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.vi.ii-p4">11. By course - According to David's appointment, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xxiv. 1-31" id="ii.xv.vi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|1Chr|24|1|24|31" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.24.1-1Chr.24.31">1 Chron. xxiv,
1-31</scripRef>, xxv, 1-22, which was only for the ordinary service, but in
extraordinary solemnities, such as this, they all came together.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.vi.ii-p5">14. Glory of the Lord - And this beautified it more than
all the gold with which it was overlaid, or the precious stones with
which it was garnished. Yet even that was no glory, in comparison of the
glory of the gospel-dispensation.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="69.38%" prev="ii.xv.vi.ii" next="ii.xv.vii.i" id="ii.xv.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. VI" id="ii.xv.vii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="69.38%" prev="ii.xv.vii" next="ii.xv.vii.ii" id="ii.xv.vii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.vii.i-p1">Solomon declares his intent in building the house, ver.
1-11. His prayer of dedication, ver. 12-42.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="69.39%" prev="ii.xv.vii.i" next="ii.xv.viii" id="ii.xv.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.vii.ii-p1">1. Thick darkness - He has indeed made darkness his
pavilion. But let this house be the residence of that darkness. It is in
the upper world that he dwells in light, such as no eye can
approach.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.vii.ii-p2">9. But thy son, &amp;c. - Thus one sows, and another
reaps. And let not the wisest of men, think it any disparagement to
pursue the good designs which those that went before them had laid.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.vii.ii-p3">14. O Lord, &amp;c. - By this prayer the temple of
Solomon is made a figure of Christ, the great Mediator thro' whom we are
to offer up all our prayers, and to expect all God's favours, and to
whom we are to have an eye in everything wherein we have to do with
God.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.vii.ii-p4">21. And when they shall, &amp;c. - He asks not, that God
would help them without their praying for themselves, but that God would
help them, in answer to their prayers. Even Christ's intercession does
not supersede, but encourage our supplications.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.vii.ii-p5">41. Arise - O thou that sittest in the heavens, arise
from the throne of thy glory, and come down into this place, which thou
hast appointed for thy constant habitation, from which thou wilt not
remove, as formerly thou hast done, from place to place. And the ark -
Thou in the ark. Thy strength - Which is the sign and instrument of thy
great power put forth from time to time on the behalf of thy people.
Salvation - Let them be encompassed on every side with thy protection
and benediction.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.vii.ii-p6">42. Thine anointed - Of me, who by thy command was
anointed the king and ruler of thy people: do not deny my requests, nor
send me from the throne of thy grace with a dejected countenance. The
mercies - Those which thou hast promised to David and to his house for
ever. And thus may we plead, with an eye to Christ, who is called David,
<scripRef passage="Hosea iii. 5" id="ii.xv.vii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Hos|3|5|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Hos.3.5">Hosea iii, 5</scripRef>. Lord, remember his merits, and accept of us, on the account
of them. Remember the promises of the everlasting covenant, which are
called the sure mercies of David, <scripRef passage="Isaiah lv. 3" id="ii.xv.vii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Isa|55|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.55.3">Isaiah lv, 3</scripRef>. This must be all our desire, all our hope, all our prayer,
and all our plea; for it is all our salvation.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="69.42%" prev="ii.xv.vii.ii" next="ii.xv.viii.i" id="ii.xv.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. VII" id="ii.xv.viii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="69.42%" prev="ii.xv.viii" next="ii.xv.viii.ii" id="ii.xv.viii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.viii.i-p1">God answers by fire, the people worship, ver. 1-3.
Solomon's sacrifices, ver. 4-7. After keeping the feast he sends the
people away, ver. 8-11. God appears to him in a vision, ver. 12-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="69.43%" prev="ii.xv.viii.i" next="ii.xv.ix" id="ii.xv.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.viii.ii-p1">1. The fire &amp;c. - In token of God's acceptance of his
prayer. The surest evidence of God's acceptance of our prayers is the
descent of his holy fire upon us. As a farther token that God accepted
Solomon's prayer, the glory of the Lord filled the house; the heart that
is filled with an holy awe and reverence of the divine glory, to which
God manifests his greatness, and (which is no less his glory) his
goodness, is thereby owned as a living temple.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.viii.ii-p2">3. With their faces - Thus expressing their awful dread
of the Divine Majesty, their chearful submission to the Divine
authority, and the sense they had of their utter unworthiness to enter
into his presence. Upon - The cloud first came down upon the house, and
then entered into the house, and was seen both within it by the priests,
and without it by the people.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.viii.ii-p3">6. David praised - For David composed the Psalms or
hymns, and appointed them to be sung by the Levites, and instrumental
music to be joined to their voices.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.viii.ii-p4">16. This house - There will I make myself known, and
there will I be called upon.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="69.44%" prev="ii.xv.viii.ii" next="ii.xv.ix.i" id="ii.xv.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. VIII" id="ii.xv.ix-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="69.44%" prev="ii.xv.ix" next="ii.xv.ix.ii" id="ii.xv.ix.i">

<p id="ii.xv.ix.i-p1">Solomon's buildings, ver. 1-6. His workmen and officers,
ver. 7-10. He settles his wife, ver. 11. Fixes the method of the temple
service, ver. 12-16. His trade, ver. 17, 18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="69.45%" prev="ii.xv.ix.i" next="ii.xv.x" id="ii.xv.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.ix.ii-p1">11. The house - He built this house for her; because the
ark was now in the house of David, which therefore ought to be kept pure
and free from the very danger and appearance of pollution.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.ix.ii-p2">14. Man of God - A prophet inspired by God in these
matters, whose commands therefore are the commands of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.ix.ii-p3">16. Prepared - All the materials were procured, and in
all points fitted and compleated before-hand.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="69.46%" prev="ii.xv.ix.ii" next="ii.xv.x.i" id="ii.xv.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. IX" id="ii.xv.x-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="69.46%" prev="ii.xv.x" next="ii.xv.x.ii" id="ii.xv.x.i">

<p id="ii.xv.x.i-p1">The queen of Sheba visits Solomon, ver. 1-12. The riches
and splendour of his court, ver. 13-28. The conclusion of his reign,
ver. 29-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="69.46%" prev="ii.xv.x.i" next="ii.xv.xi" id="ii.xv.x.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.x.ii-p1">8. For the Lord - In the Lord's name and stead, in a
special manner, because he sat in God's own throne, and ruled over God's
peculiar people, and did in an eminent manner maintain the honour of God
in his land, and in the eyes of all the world. Those mercies are doubly
sweet, in which we can taste the kindness and good will of God as our
God.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.x.ii-p2">12. Besides - Besides what he gave her of his royal
bounty, as is expressed, <scripRef passage="1 Kings x. 13" id="ii.xv.x.ii-p2.1" parsed="|1Kgs|10|13|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.10.13">1 Kings x, 13</scripRef>, which was in compensation for her presents.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.x.ii-p3">23. And all the kings of the earth sought the presence of
Solomon -All in those parts of the world.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.x.ii-p4">29. Iddo - This, and the other prophets mentioned, were
also historians, and wrote annals of their times; out of which these
sacred books were taken, either by these, or other prophets.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.x.ii-p5">31. And Solomon slept - We have here Solomon in his
throne, and Solomon in his grave; for the throne could not secure him
from the grave. Here is he stripped of his pomp, and leaving all his
wealth and power, not to one whom he knew not whether he would be a wise
man or a fool; but one he knew would be a fool! This was not only
vanity, but vexation of spirit.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="69.48%" prev="ii.xv.x.ii" next="ii.xv.xi.i" id="ii.xv.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. X" id="ii.xv.xi-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="69.48%" prev="ii.xv.xi" next="ii.xv.xi.ii" id="ii.xv.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xi.i-p1">The people request Rehoboam to ease their grievances,
ver. 1-5. Rehoboam rejecting the old mens counsel, by the advice of the
young men answers them roughly, ver. 6-15. Ten tribes revolt, ver.
16-19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="69.48%" prev="ii.xv.xi.i" next="ii.xv.xii" id="ii.xv.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xi.ii-p1">4. Grievous - It is probable, when Solomon had declined
from God, that God left him to himself to act thus impolitically.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xi.ii-p2">7. If thou be kind, &amp;c. - Moderate counsels are
generally best. Gentleness will do what violence will not do. Good words
cost nothing but a little self-denial, and yet they purchase great
things.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xi.ii-p3">16. See to thine own house - When public affairs are in a
ferment, violent proceedings do but make ill worse. Many have been
driven to the mischief they did not intend, by being too severely dealt
with.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="69.49%" prev="ii.xv.xi.ii" next="ii.xv.xii.i" id="ii.xv.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XI" id="ii.xv.xii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="69.49%" prev="ii.xv.xii" next="ii.xv.xii.ii" id="ii.xv.xii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xii.i-p1">Rehoboam is forbidden to fight against Israel, ver. 1-4.
He secures the two tribes, ver. 5-12. The priests and Levites resort to
him, ver. 13-17. His wives and children, ver. 18-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="69.49%" prev="ii.xv.xii.i" next="ii.xv.xiii" id="ii.xv.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xii.ii-p1">3. Son of Solomon - Intimating, that this was determined
for the sin of Solomon, and therefore could not be reversed.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xii.ii-p2">5. Built - Repaired, enlarged, and fortified them. They
were built before.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xii.ii-p3">14. Cast them off - They would not suffer them to
instruct the Israelites in the worship of God, nor to go up to Jerusalem
to worship in their courses: and these priests would not join with them
in the worship of the calves, as they were commanded to do; and
therefore they, willingly forsook all their patrimonies and possessions
for God's sake. No secular advantages whatsoever should detain us there,
where we are in danger of making shipwreck of faith and a good
conscience.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xii.ii-p4">15. High places - Or, for the high places, both for the
devils (the Baals, or false gods, which divers of his people worshipped,
whom he encouraged to do so, giving them liberty to do anything but to
serve God at Jerusalem) and for the calves. So he erected two sorts of
high places, some for Baal, and some for the true God, whom be pretended
to worship, in and by the calves.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xii.ii-p5">16. Set their heart - Such as loved and feared God in
truth.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xii.ii-p6">17. So they strengthened the kingdom of Judah - Not only
by the addition of so many persons to it: but by their piety and prayers
they procured a blessing upon the kingdom which was a sanctuary to them.
They made him strong three years; for so long he served God; but when he
forsook God, none could strengthen him. We retain our strength as long
as we cleave to God and our duty, and no longer. And Solomon - This
honourable mention of Solomon, as a pattern of piety, is a considerable
evidence of his true repentance before his death.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xii.ii-p7">22. Ruler - He declared him his successor, and gave him
the dominion over, his brethren.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xii.ii-p8">23. Dispersed - Lest his other sons should after his
death unite together against Abijah, he wisely dispersed them into
distant places.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="69.53%" prev="ii.xv.xii.ii" next="ii.xv.xiii.i" id="ii.xv.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XII" id="ii.xv.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="69.53%" prev="ii.xv.xiii" next="ii.xv.xiii.ii" id="ii.xv.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xiii.i-p1">Rehoboam forsaking God is oppressed by Shishak, ver. 1-4.
He humbles himself, and is preserved in his kingdom, but spoiled of his
treasures, ver. 6-12. His character and death, ver. 13-16.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="69.53%" prev="ii.xv.xiii.i" next="ii.xv.xiv" id="ii.xv.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xiii.ii-p1">1. And all Israel - So called, because they forsook God,
as Israel had done.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiii.ii-p2">2. Fifth year - Presently after the apostacy of the king
and people, which was in the fourth year.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiii.ii-p3">3. Lubims - A people of Africk bordering upon Egypt.
Sukkiims - A people living in tents, as the word signifies; and such
there were not far from Egypt, both in Africk and in Arabia. Ethiopians
- Either those beyond Egypt, or the Arabians.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiii.ii-p4">7. Some deliverance - I will give some stop to the course
of my wrath, which was ready to be poured forth upon them to their utter
destruction. Those who acknowledge God is righteous in afflicting them,
shall find him gracious.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiii.ii-p5">8. May know - That they may experimentally know the
difference between my yoke and the yoke of a foreign and idolatrous
prince.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiii.ii-p6">12. Went well - The began to recruity themselves, and
regain some degree of their former prosperity.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiii.ii-p7">14. Did evil - Or, settled not, although he humbled
himself, for a season, yet he quickly relapsed into sin, because his
heart was not right with God.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="69.55%" prev="ii.xv.xiii.ii" next="ii.xv.xiv.i" id="ii.xv.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XIII" id="ii.xv.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="69.55%" prev="ii.xv.xiv" next="ii.xv.xiv.ii" id="ii.xv.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.i-p1">Abijah sets the battle in array against Jeroboam, ver.
1-3. He declares the justice of his cause, ver. 4-12. Trusts in God and
gains the victory, ver. 13-20. His wives and children, ver. 21. 22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="69.55%" prev="ii.xv.xiv.i" next="ii.xv.xv" id="ii.xv.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p1">5. Of salt - By a perpetual covenant.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p2">8. Golden calves - There is that among you which may damp
your confidence: you worship those images which God abhors.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p3">9. Consecrate - To make himself a priest.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p4">10. The Lord - Hebrew. Jehovah, the only true God. We -
Maintain his worship which you have rejected.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p5">11. Pure table - Made of pure gold, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxv. 23, 24" id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Exod|25|23|25|24" osisRef="Bible:Exod.25.23-Exod.25.24">Exod. xxv, 23, 24</scripRef>, he saith table and candlestick, though there were ten of
each, because ordinarily there was but one of each used at a time for
those uses. We keep - Perhaps he flattered himself, that his keeping up
the external worship of God would make satisfaction for the errors of
his life.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p6">12. Trumpets - Upon the sounding whereof God hath
solemnly promised to assist his people, <scripRef passage="Num. x. 9" id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Num|10|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.10.9">Num. x, 9</scripRef>. The Lord - You have not only us for your enemies, but God,
even the God whom your fathers served. It is folly to fight against the
God of almighty power: but it is treachery and base ingratitude, to
fight against your father's God.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p7">13. Jeroboam - While Abijah was discoursing, Jeroboam
takes the advantage of it to lay an ambush. It does not appear that he
made any answer to all that Abijah said. The longest sword he thinks
will determine the matter, not the better cause.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p8">15. Gave a shout - It is unspeakable comfort, that no
stratagem or ambush can cut off our communication with heaven. To the
cry of prayer they added the shout of faith, and so became more than
conquerors.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p9">20. The Lord struck him - He escaped the sword of Abijah:
but God struck him: there is no escaping his sword.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xiv.ii-p10">21. Married - Not after this victory, for he died
presently after it, but in the whole time of his life.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="69.58%" prev="ii.xv.xiv.ii" next="ii.xv.xv.i" id="ii.xv.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XIV" id="ii.xv.xv-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="69.58%" prev="ii.xv.xv" next="ii.xv.xv.ii" id="ii.xv.xv.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xv.i-p1">The piety of Asa, ver. 1-5. His policy, ver. 6-8. His
victory over the Ethiopians, ver. 9-15.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="69.58%" prev="ii.xv.xv.i" next="ii.xv.xvi" id="ii.xv.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xv.ii-p1">1. Quiet - There was no open war, but there were private
hostilities between his and Baasha's subjects.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xv.ii-p2">6. The land had rest - Those have rest indeed, to whom
God gives rest; peace indeed, to whom Christ gives peace. We find by
experience, it is good to seek the Lord. While we pursue the world, we
meet with nothing but vexation.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xv.ii-p3">7. Before us - In our power.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xv.ii-p4">9. Ethiopian - Or, the Arabian, as the Hebrew word Cush
is commonly used: these being much nearer to Asa than the
Ethiopians.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xv.ii-p5">11. Let not man prevail - If he prevails against us, he
prevails, as it were, against thee; because thou art our God. And we
rest on thee, and go forth in thy name, which thou hast encouraged us to
do.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xv.ii-p6">12. Smote - With terror, and an unaccountable
consternation.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xv.ii-p7">14. Smote the cities - because they had joined, with
Zerah in this war.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="69.60%" prev="ii.xv.xv.ii" next="ii.xv.xvi.i" id="ii.xv.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XV" id="ii.xv.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="69.60%" prev="ii.xv.xvi" next="ii.xv.xvi.ii" id="ii.xv.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xvi.i-p1">God's message to Asa, ver. 1-7. Idols removed and the
spoil dedicated to God, ver. 8-11. Judah makes a covenant with God, ver.
12-15. Asa removes his mother, destroys her idol, and brings the
dedicated things into the temple, ver. 16-18. He has great peace, ver.
19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="69.60%" prev="ii.xv.xvi.i" next="ii.xv.xvii" id="ii.xv.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xvi.ii-p1">1. Spirit of God - Both to instruct him what to say, and
to enable him to say it plainly and boldly.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvi.ii-p2">3. Now Israel - They have long lived without the found
knowledge and worship of the true God. Israel is here understood of the
whole nation of Israel in former times, and especially in the times of
the Judges: for then many times they were in a great measure, without
God and his law, and teaching priests, as plainly appears from the book
of the Judges; they were brought to all the exigencies and calamities
following; and they sometimes turned to the Lord, and he was found of
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvi.ii-p3">5. In those times - When Israel lived in the gross
neglect of God and his law. No peace - Men could not go abroad about
their private occasions without great danger; as it was in the days of
Shamgar, <scripRef passage="Judg. v. 6" id="ii.xv.xvi.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Judg|5|6|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Judg.5.6">Judg. v, 6</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvi.ii-p4">6. And nation, &amp;c. - One part of the people of Israel
destroyed the other by civil wars. As all Israel are called a nation, so
the several tribes of them are sometimes called nations.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvi.ii-p5">7. Be strong - Go on resolutely to maintain God's worship
and to root out idolatry, as you have begun to do; for this is the only
method of preserving yourselves from such calamities as your
predecessors have felt.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvi.ii-p6">8. Of Oded - Of Azariah, ver. 1, who was also called by
his father's name Oded.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvi.ii-p7">12. Into covenant - The matter of this covenant was
nothing but what they were before obliged to. And tho' no promise could
lay any higher obligation upon them, than they were already under, yet
it would help to increase their sense of the obligation, and to arm them
against temptations. And by joining all together in this, they
strengthened the hands of each other</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvi.ii-p8">15. Rejoiced at the oath - The times of renewing our
covenant with God, should be times of rejoicing. It is an honour and
happiness to be in bonds with God. And the closer, the better.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVI" progress="69.64%" prev="ii.xv.xvi.ii" next="ii.xv.xvii.i" id="ii.xv.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XVI" id="ii.xv.xvii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|16|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.16" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xvii-p0.2">XVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVI" progress="69.64%" prev="ii.xv.xvii" next="ii.xv.xvii.ii" id="ii.xv.xvii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xvii.i-p1">Asa hires the Syrians to invade Israel, ver. 1-6. Puts
the prophet who reproved him for it in prison, ver. 7-10. His sickness,
death and burial, ver, 11-14.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVI" progress="69.64%" prev="ii.xv.xvii.i" next="ii.xv.xviii" id="ii.xv.xvii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xvii.ii-p1">1. Of the reign - Or, of the kingdom of Asa, that is, of
the kingdom of Judah, which was now Asa's kingdom; or from the time of
the division of the two kingdoms. Rehoboam reigned seventeen years,
Abijah three years, Asa had now reigned fifteen years, all which put
together, make up the thirty five years mentioned chap. xv, 19, and in
the next year Baasha wars against him; and the ground of the war was the
defection of many of his subjects to Asa, chap. xv, 9.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvii.ii-p2">7. Escaped - And so reserved to be a scourge to thy
kingdom and posterity: whereas if he had joined with Baasha against
thee, thou shouldst have overthrown them both, and prevented all that
mischief which that monarch will do to thy family.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvii.ii-p3">8. Lubims - Either, the Lybians in Africa; or another
people, possibly descended from them, but now seated in some part of
Arabia.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvii.ii-p4">9. Done foolishly - It is a foolish thing to lean on a
broken reed, when we have the rock of ages to rely upon. Perfect -
Upright and sincere, as thine is not. He was sincere in the general
course of his life, but some particulars, whereof this is one, his heart
did not perfectly cleave to God.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvii.ii-p5">12. Sought not - He did not humble himself before God,
but put his confidence in the skill and faithfulness of his physicians.
His making use of physicians was his duty, but his trusting in them, and
expecting that from them, which was to be had from God only, was his sin
and folly. The help of every creature must be used, with an eye to the
creator, and in dependence on him, who makes every creature that to us
which it is, without whom the most skilful and faithful are physicians
of no value.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xvii.ii-p6">14. Burning - Of precious spices; thereby testifying
their respect to him notwithstanding his miscarriages.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVII" progress="69.67%" prev="ii.xv.xvii.ii" next="ii.xv.xviii.i" id="ii.xv.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XVII" id="ii.xv.xviii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|17|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.17" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xviii-p0.2">XVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVII" progress="69.67%" prev="ii.xv.xviii" next="ii.xv.xviii.ii" id="ii.xv.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xviii.i-p1">Jehoshaphat is established in his kingdom, ver. 1-3. His
piety, ver. 4-6. He sends Levites to teach Judah, ver. 7-9. His
influence over his neighbours, ver. 10, 11. His greatness, captains and
armies, ver. 12-19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVII" progress="69.67%" prev="ii.xv.xviii.i" next="ii.xv.xix" id="ii.xv.xviii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xviii.ii-p1">3. Sought not, &amp;c. - It is true, he recovered from
that fall. "Yet perhaps, says Mr. Henry, he never, while he lived, fully
retrieved the spiritual strength he lost by it."</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xviii.ii-p2">5. Brought presents - As subjects in those times used to
do to their kings, as a token of their respect and subjection to
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xviii.ii-p3">6. Lifted up - Above all discouragements, and fears. He
was valiant and resolute for God and his ways. Groves - Those wherein
idols were worshipped, and though Asa had done this before, yet either
he did not do it thoroughly; or the Jews (who were many of them mad upon
their idols) had secretly made new ones, in the latter part of his
reign, when he grew more infirm in body, and more remiss in God's
cause.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xviii.ii-p4">7. To teach - To inform the people of their duty, and of
the king's pleasure, as Judges teach or instruct the people in the laws
of the land, when they deliver their charges upon the bench; so did
these princes in the king's name admonish and require the people to
observe and obey the laws of God, which were the municipal laws of that
land: the particular explication and enforcement whereof, they left to
the Levites and priests here following, who were sent for this end, and
accordingly taught the people, ver. 9.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xviii.ii-p5">9. And they taught, &amp;c. - And these itinerant Judges
and itinerant preachers together, Mr. Henry observes were instrumental
to diffuse a blessed light throughout the cities of Judah.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xviii.ii-p6">10. Fear fell - Justly concluding from his singular piety
that God would eminently appear for him, for even the Heathens could not
but observe, that the kings of Judah were either prosperous or unhappy,
according as they served God or forsook him.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xviii.ii-p7">13. Business - To repair and fortify them, and furnish
them with provisions: and to purge out all their relicks of idolatry and
injustice.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xviii.ii-p8">19. Waited - These above-mentioned were the trained bands
or auxiliaries: whose chief officers waited on the king to receive his
commands, and to raise, and bring in all, or part of their forces, to
the service of the king as need required. A vast number for so small a
compass of ground, to furnish out and maintain. But we may consider,
that God had promised to make the seed of Abraham like the sand of the
sea for number; that there had now been a long peace; that many were
come to them from the kingdom of Israel and that Jehoshaphat was under a
special blessing of God. They were doubtless dispersed all the country
over, every one residing on his own land: only they were ready at call,
whenever there was occasion.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XVIII" progress="69.72%" prev="ii.xv.xviii.ii" next="ii.xv.xix.i" id="ii.xv.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XVIII" id="ii.xv.xix-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|18|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.18" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xix-p0.2">XVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XVIII" progress="69.72%" prev="ii.xv.xix" next="ii.xv.xix.ii" id="ii.xv.xix.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xix.i-p1">Jehoshaphat joins affinity with Ahab, and consents to go
with him to Ramoth-gilead, ver. 1-3. The false prophets promise them
success, ver. 4-11. Micaiah foretells the death of Ahab, ver. 6-27.
Jehoshaphat hardly escapes, ver. 28-32. Ahab slain, ver. 33, 34.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XVIII" progress="69.72%" prev="ii.xv.xix.i" next="ii.xv.xx" id="ii.xv.xix.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xix.ii-p1">1. With Ahab - For Joram's eldest son married Athaliah,
Ahab's daughter.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xix.ii-p2">4. Inquire, &amp;c. - This we should do, whatever we
undertake, by particular, believing prayer, by an unbiased consulting of
the scriptures and our own consciences, and by a close regard to the
hints of providence.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xix.ii-p3">22. Lying spirit, &amp;c. - See the power of Satan! One
lying spirit can make four hundred lying prophets. And thus he
frequently becomes a murderer by being a liar, and destroys men by
deceiving them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xix.ii-p4">26. This fellow, &amp;c. - How frequently has this been
the lot of faithful ministers, to be hated and ill treated, merely for
being true to God: and just and kind to the souls of men! But that day
will declare who is in the right, and who is in the wrong, when Christ
appears to the unspeakable consolation of the persecuted, and the
everlasting confusion of their persecutors.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xix.ii-p5">31. Cried out - He cried out, either to his friends to
help, or to his enemies, to let them know, he was not the king of
Israel: or to God, and not in vain; for he moved the captains to depart
from him. Many are moved in a manner unaccountable both to themselves
and others; but an invisible power moves them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xix.ii-p6">34. He died - What can hurt those whom God will protect?
And what can shelter those whom God will destroy? Jehoshaphat is saved
in his robes; Ahab is killed in his armour!</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIX" progress="69.75%" prev="ii.xv.xix.ii" next="ii.xv.xx.i" id="ii.xv.xx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XIX" id="ii.xv.xx-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|19|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.19" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xx-p0.2">XIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIX" progress="69.75%" prev="ii.xv.xx" next="ii.xv.xx.ii" id="ii.xv.xx.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xx.i-p1">Jehoshaphat is reproved by a prophet, ver. 1-3. He
reforms the kingdom, ver. 4. Gives instructions to the itinerant Judges,
ver. 5-7. And to the supreme court at Jerusalem, ver. 8-11.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIX" progress="69.75%" prev="ii.xv.xx.i" next="ii.xv.xxi" id="ii.xv.xx.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p1">2. Therefore - Therefore God will chastise thee for this
miscarriage. Which he did partly by stirring up the Moabites, and others
to invade him, chap. xx, 1, partly by permitting his eldest son Jehoram
to kill all his brethren, chap. xxi, 4, and principally by bringing that
almost general destruction upon his grand- children by Jehu, <scripRef passage="2 Kings ix. 27" id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p1.1" parsed="|2Kgs|9|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.9.27">2 Kings ix, 27</scripRef>; x, 13, 14, which was the fruit of his alliance with
Ahab.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p2">3. Good things - Good marks proceeding from an honest
heart; which God more regards than this particular error: and therefore
though he will chasten thee, yet he will not utterly destroy thee.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p3">4. Through - Through the whole kingdom, whereof these
were the two bounds. And brought - Such of them as had revolted from God
to idols, he reclaimed by his counsel and example, and by the
instructions of the Levites and priests, whom he carried with him. Many,
probably, had revolted to idolatry, when they saw their king so intimate
with idolaters. Therefore he thought himself doubly obliged to do all he
could to reduce them. If we truly repent of sin, we shall do our utmost
to repair the damage we have done to religion, or the souls of
others.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p4">6. The Lord - You represent God's person to whom judgment
belongeth, you have your commission from God, and not from man only; and
your administration of justice is not only for man's good, but also for
God's honour and service. With you - Both to observe your carriage, and
to defend you against all those enemies whom the impartial exercise of
justice may provoke.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p5">7. Wherefore - And therefore you who are in God's stead,
and do his work, and must give an account to him, must imitate God
herein.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p6">8. The fathers - Persons of other tribes eminent for
their dignity, ability and integrity. But whether these persons made up
one court, called the Sanhedrim, by which all causes ecclesiastical and
civil were decided; or there were two distinct courts, the one
ecclesiastical, consisting of the priests and Levites; the other civil,
consisting of the chief of the fathers of Israel, it is not easy to
determine. The Lord - For matters concerning the laws and worship, of
God. Controversies - For matters of difference between man and man. When
- When Jehoshaphat and his company were returned to Jerusalem, he made
this order concerning establishing Judges there.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p7">10. Blood - This refers to <scripRef passage="Deut. xvii. 8" id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Deut|17|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.17.8">Deut. xvii, 8</scripRef>, between the blood of the person slain, and the blood of the
man-slayer. All the cities of refuge, except Hebron, now belonged to the
kingdom of Israel, so that the man-slayer now usually fled to the courts
of the temple, or the horns of the altar. And therefore the trial of
these, was reserved for the court at Jerusalem. Law, &amp;c. - When any
debates shall arise about the meaning of any of God's laws. Warn - Ye
shall not only give a righteous sentence for what is past, but ye shall
admonish the offender, and others, to take better heed for the
future.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xx.ii-p8">11. Over you - Shall be your president. Matters of the
Lord - In Spiritual, or ecclesiastical matters. Ruler - The prince, or
chief ruler, under the king, of the tribe of Judah. The king's matters -
For civil causes, or controversies either between the king and his
people; or between subject and subject, which may be called the king's
matters, because it was a principal part of his office to see them
justly decided. The Levites - Shall be at your command to see your just
sentences executed; which work was fitly committed to the Levites, as
persons who might add their instructions to the corrections, and might
work the guilty to an acknowledgement of their fault and a submission to
their punishment. The Lord - Shall protect and bless good Judges.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XX" progress="69.82%" prev="ii.xv.xx.ii" next="ii.xv.xxi.i" id="ii.xv.xxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XX" id="ii.xv.xxi-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|20|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.20" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxi-p0.2">XX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XX" progress="69.82%" prev="ii.xv.xxi" next="ii.xv.xxi.ii" id="ii.xv.xxi.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.i-p1">The land being invaded, Jehoshaphat and all the people
seek God by fasting and prayer, ver. 1-13. They thankfully receive the
promise of victory given by a prophet, ver. 14-19. Their enemies are
overthrown, ver. 20-25. Their thanksgiving, ver. 25-30. The conclusion
of his reign, ver. 31-37.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XX" progress="69.82%" prev="ii.xv.xxi.i" next="ii.xv.xxii" id="ii.xv.xxi.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p1">2. The sea - The dead sea, beyond which mount Seir lay.
Syria - Largely so called, and so it includes the Moabites and
Ammonites. And it may be thus expressed, to intimate that they came by
the instigation of the Syrians, to revenge themselves of Jehoshaphat for
joining with Ahab against them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p2">5. The house - Largely so called, in the court of the
people, upon that brazen scaffold which Solomon had erected. New court -
Before the priests court: which is called the new court, because it had
lately been renewed when the altar was renewed.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p3">7. Abraham - To whom thou hast engaged thyself by
covenant to be his friend, and the friend of his seed forever. 9. The
sword - Or rather, the sword of judgement or of vengeance, that is, war,
whereby thou punisheth thy people for their sins.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p4">12. Wilt thou not judge - Wilt thou not give sentence
against them, and execute it upon them? The justice of God is the refuge
of those that are wronged. No might - Though he had great armies, yet he
seems to have been surprized by these men, before his forces were in
readiness to oppose them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p5">13. Little ones - Whom they used to present before the
Lord in times of great distress, to stir up themselves to more fervent
prayers, their eyes being upon their harmless and tender children, and
to move God to compassion, because God hath declared, that he will be
prevailed with, by such methods as these.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p6">15. But God's - God will fight for you, and he alone will
do the work, you need not strike a stroke.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p7">16. Go down - From Jerusalem, where he and his army now
were; which stood upon high ground.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p8">19. Stood up - By Jehoshaphat's appointment. On high -
With heart and voice lifted up: whereby they shewed their full assurance
of the victory.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p9">20. Believe - God's promise delivered to us by this
prophet, and consequently all other predictions of the prophet.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p10">21. Consulted - Jehoshaphat called a counsel of war, and
it was resolved, to appoint singers to go out before the army, who had
nothing to do, but to praise God, to praise his holiness, which is his
beauty, to praise him as they did in the temple, that beauty of
holiness. By this strange advance to the field of battle, Jehoshaphat
shewed his firm reliance on the word of God, which enabled him to
triumph before the battle, to animate his own men and confound the
enemy.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p11">22. To sing - So acceptable are the fervent prayers of
God's people to God, and so terrible to their enemies. Ambushments - Or,
liers in wait, either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p12">1. the holy angels, who appeared in the
shape of men, and possibly put on the appearances and visages of the
Moabites or Ammonites, and in that shape slew the rest, who supposing
this slaughter to be done by a part of their own army, fell upon them,
and so broke forth into mutual slaughters. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p13">2. God raised jealousies and animosities
among themselves, which broke forth, first into secret ambushments,
which one party laid for another, and then into open hostilities to
their utter destruction. So vain are all mens attempts against God, who
needs none to destroy his enemies but themselves, and their own
mistakes, and passions, which he can, when he pleaseth, arm against
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p14">24. The watch tower - Which stood upon the cliff of Ziz,
mentioned ver. 16, and looked toward the wilderness, where their enemies
lay encamped, whose numbers, and order, and condition, they could descry
from thence.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p15">25. Jewels - Which they brought with them to corrupt any
of Jehoshaphat's officers as they saw occasion: to procure necessaries
for their vast army from time to time: and because they came as to
triumph rather than to fight, being confident of the victory because of
their numbers, and especially because they thought to surprize
Jehoshaphat ere he could make any considerable preparations against
them; God also permitting them to be puffed up to their own
destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p16">26. Berachah - Hebrew. of blessing; so called from their
solemn blessings and praises given to God in it upon this occasion.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p17">28. To the house - To renew their praises in the court of
the temple, the proper and usual place for it. Praising God must not be
the work of a day only, but our praises when we have received mercy,
must be often repeated, as our prayers were, when we where in pursuit of
it. Every day we must bless God: as long as we live, and while we have
any being, we must praise him, spending our time in that work, in which
we hope to spend our eternity.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p18">33. Not taken - Not universally; the fault was not in
Jehoshaphat, but in the people, who, though they did worship the true
God, yet would not be confined to the temple, but for their own
conveniency, or from their affection to their ancient custom chose to
worship him in the high-places.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxi.ii-p19">35. After this - This is mentioned as an aggravation of
his sin, after so great an obligation laid upon him by God; and after he
had been so singularly reproved by a prophet yet he relapsed into the
same sin which proceeded partly from that near relation which was
contracted between the two families, and partly from the easiness of
Jehoshaphat's temper, which could not resist the solicitations of
others, in such things as might seem indifferent. For he did not join
with him in war, as he did with Ahab, but in a peaceable way only, in a
matter of trade and commerce. And yet God reproves and punisheth him for
it, ver. 37, to shew his great dislike of all familiar conversation of
his servants and people with professed enemies of God and of religion,
as Ahaziah was. Very wickedly - Or who did industriously, and
maliciously, and constantly work wickedness, as the Hebrew phrase
implies, giving himself up to idolatry and all wickedness.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXI" progress="69.92%" prev="ii.xv.xxi.ii" next="ii.xv.xxii.i" id="ii.xv.xxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXI" id="ii.xv.xxii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|21|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.21" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxii-p0.2">XXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXI" progress="69.92%" prev="ii.xv.xxii" next="ii.xv.xxii.ii" id="ii.xv.xxii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.i-p1">Jehoram succeeds, ver. 1-3. His wickedness, ver. 4-7.
Edom and Libnah revolt and Jehoram is still more wicked, ver. 8-11. The
prophecy of Elijah against him, ver. 12-15. The success of his enemies,
ver. 16, 17. His sickness and death, ver. 18-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXI" progress="69.93%" prev="ii.xv.xxii.i" next="ii.xv.xxiii" id="ii.xv.xxii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p1">2. Azariah - Two sons called by the same name, though
doubtless distinguished by some additional title: which is not mentioned
here, because it did not concern succeeding ages to know it. Of Israel -
So he is called either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p2">1. Because he was so by right: or</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p3">2. Because he was king not only of Judah
and Benjamin, but of a great number of Israelites, who had come and
settled in his kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p4">4. Strengthened himself - He hardened his heart, as that
word sometimes signifies. Princes - The chief of those Israelites, who
out of love to God and the true religion, had forsaken their estates in
the kingdom of Israel, and were now incorporated with the kingdom of
Judah: because he thought these would be most zealous for that religion
which he was resolved to oppose.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p5">10. Libnah - Libnah seems to have set up for a free
state. And the reason is here given, both why God permitted it, and why
they did it, because Jehoram was become an idolater. While he adhered to
God, they adhered to him; but when he cast God off, they cast him off.
Whether this would justify them in their revolt or no, it justified
God's providence which suffered it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p6">11. High places - Not to the Lord, but to Baals or false
gods. And caused - Not only by his counsel and example, but by force, by
threats, and penalties.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p7">12. From Elijah - By this it appears, that Jehoram came
to the throne before Elijah's translation. It is true, we find Elisha
attending Jehoshaphat; but that might be, while Elijah was yet on earth:
for we read of Jehoram's coming to the crown, before we read of Elijah's
translation, <scripRef passage="1 Kings xxii. 50" id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p7.1" parsed="|1Kgs|22|50|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.22.50">1 Kings xxii, 50</scripRef>. We may suppose, the time of his departure was at hand, so
that he could not go in person to Jehoram. But he left this writing,
probably with Elisha, to be sent the first opportunity. The message is
sent in the name of the Lord God of David his father, upbraiding him
with his relation to David, as that which was no more his honour, but an
aggravation of his degeneracy.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p8">15. People - Because the generality of them sinned, in
complying with his wicked and idolatrous commands. Wives - Whose lives
shall go for the lives of thy brethren, ver. 4.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p9">16. Philistines - A people fully subdued and dispirited:
but God now raises their spirits and courage to do his work. Ethiopians
- A people in Arabia, so called, either for their likeness in complexion
to the Ethiopians, or because the one of these people were a colony of
the other.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p10">17. His wives - Whom also they slew, chap. xxii, 1,
except Ahaziah and Athaliah; who possibly were hidden in some secret
place. Left him - Blood for blood. He had slain all his brethren; they
slay all his sons, but one. And he had not escaped, had be not been of
the house of David; which must not be extirpated, like that of Ahab:
because a blessing was in it; no less a blessing than that of the
Messiah.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxii.ii-p11">20. Desired - This is an emphatical expression, because
it is usual with men to desire the deaths of some persons, whom
afterward they lament, and heartily wish they were alive again. But for
this ungodly and unhappy prince, his people did not only in his life
time wish his death, but afterwards did not repent of those desires.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXII" progress="69.98%" prev="ii.xv.xxii.ii" next="ii.xv.xxiii.i" id="ii.xv.xxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXII" id="ii.xv.xxiii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|22|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.22" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxiii-p0.2">XXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXII" progress="69.98%" prev="ii.xv.xxiii" next="ii.xv.xxiii.ii" id="ii.xv.xxiii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxiii.i-p1">Ahaziah's wicked reign, ver. 1-4. Being confederate with
Joram, he is slain by Jehu, ver. 5-9. Athaliah destroys the seed royal,
and usurps the kingdom, ver. 10-12.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXII" progress="69.98%" prev="ii.xv.xxiii.i" next="ii.xv.xxiv" id="ii.xv.xxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxiii.ii-p1">2. Forty two years - Some acknowledge an error in the
transcribers of the present Hebrew copies, in which language the numeral
letters for 22 and</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxiii.ii-p2">42 are so like, that they might easily be mistaken. For
that it was read 22 here, as it is in the book of Kings, in other Hebrew
copies, they gather from hence, that it is at this day so read in divers
ancient Greek copies, as also in those two ancient translations, the
Syriack and the Arabick, and particularly in that most ancient copy of
the Syriack which was used by the church of Antioch in the primitive
times, and to this day is kept in the church of Antioch. The daughter -
Of Ahab, Omri's Son. Grand-children are often called sons and
daughters.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxiii.ii-p3">4. His father - Who, while he lived, seduced his son
himself, and made other evil counsellors unnecessary.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxiii.ii-p4">9. Ahaziah - Who, tho' wounded, had made an escape, <scripRef passage="2 Kings ix. 27" id="ii.xv.xxiii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|2Kgs|9|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.9.27">2 Kings ix,
27</scripRef>.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIII" progress="70.00%" prev="ii.xv.xxiii.ii" next="ii.xv.xxiv.i" id="ii.xv.xxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXIII" id="ii.xv.xxiv-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|23|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.23" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxiv-p0.2">XXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIII" progress="70.00%" prev="ii.xv.xxiv" next="ii.xv.xxiv.ii" id="ii.xv.xxiv.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxiv.i-p1">Jehoiada prepares the people and crowns the king, ver. 1-
11. Athaliah is slain, ver. 12-15. The kingdom is reformed, ver.
16-21.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIII" progress="70.00%" prev="ii.xv.xxiv.i" next="ii.xv.xxv" id="ii.xv.xxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxiv.ii-p1">5. Foundation - At the east gate, so called because it
stood lower than the rest of the doors at the foot of the steps, by
which they went up from the king's house to the temple.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxiv.ii-p2">11. His sons - And Zechariah among the rest, whom
afterwards he ungratefully slew, chap. xxiv, 21.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxiv.ii-p3">13. Rejoiced - To see a rod sprung out of the stem of
Jesse! To see what they despaired of ever seeing, a king of the house of
David.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxiv.ii-p4">16. Him - The Lord, as is expressed, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xi. 17" id="ii.xv.xxiv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|2Kgs|11|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.11.17">2 Kings xi, 17</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxiv.ii-p5">18. Appointed - Or, as it is in the Hebrew, put the
offices of the house of the Lord into the hand, that is, he restored the
priests and Levites to the exercise of their office.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxiv.ii-p6">21. Rejoiced, &amp;c. - The generality of the people
rejoiced, the rest were quiet and made no opposition. When the Son of
David is enthroned in the soul, all therein is quiet, and springs of joy
are opened.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIV" progress="70.02%" prev="ii.xv.xxiv.ii" next="ii.xv.xxv.i" id="ii.xv.xxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXIV" id="ii.xv.xxv-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|24|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.24" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxv-p0.2">XXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIV" progress="70.02%" prev="ii.xv.xxv" next="ii.xv.xxv.ii" id="ii.xv.xxv.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.i-p1">Joash takes care to repair the temple, ver. 1-14. After
Jehoiada's death, he sets up the worship of Baal again, tho' warned,
ver. 15-19. He puts Zechariah to death, ver. 20-22. Is invaded by the
Syrians, ver. 23, 24. Struck with sore diseases and slain, ver.
25-27</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIV" progress="70.02%" prev="ii.xv.xxv.i" next="ii.xv.xxvi" id="ii.xv.xxv.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p1">6. The chief - It is observable, that he is not called
the chief priest, or high-priest, but only the chief, or the head, which
he might be in many other respects, either by reason of his near
relation to the royal family: or because he was the chief of one of the
twenty- four families.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p2">7. The sons - Ahaziah, and his brethren before they were
carried away captive, chap. xxi, 17, who did this by her instigation, as
this phrase implies. Broke up - Both broke up the treasuries, and
defaced the house itself.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p3">14. Vessels - Because Athaliah and her sons had taken the
old ones away, ver. 7.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p4">15. An hundred and thirty years old - By which it
appears, that he was born in Solomon's time, and had lived six entire
reigns before this. They buried him among the kings, with this
honourable encomium, (perhaps inscribed upon his grave-stone) that he
had done good in Israel. But the little religion that Joash had, was all
buried in his grave. See how great a judgment to any prince or people,
the death of holy, useful men is!</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p5">16. Israel - In Judah, which was an eminent part of
Israel, and the only part of it which owned God, or was owned by God as
his Israel, to whom therefore he often appropriates this name.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p6">17. Made obeisance - In that posture presenting their
requests to him, that they might not be confined to troublesome journeys
to Jerusalem, but might have the liberty, which their fore-fathers
enjoyed, os worshipping God in the high-places. This liberty once
obtained, they knew they could worship idols without disturbance: which
was the thing at which they aimed. And for the prevention of such
abuses, God obliged all to worship him in one place.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p7">18. Left, &amp;c. - The king and princes that awhile ago
so zealously repaired the temple, now forsook the temple! So inconstant
a thing is man! So little confidence is to be put in him!</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p8">20. Who stood - The people were assembled in the court of
the temple, which they had not quite forsook, when Zechariah stood up in
some of the desks that were in the court of the priests, and plainly
told them their sin, and the consequences of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p9">21. Stoned him - They stoned him immediately, without
even colour of law; as horrid a piece of wickedness, as any we read of
in all the history of the kings. That ever such a villainy should be
committed, by men, by Israelites, in contempt and violation of
everything that is just, honourable, and sacred! The Jews say, there
were seven transgressions in one: They killed a priest, a prophet, a
judge; they shed innocent blood; polluted the court of the temple, the
Sabbath, and the day of expiation: for on that day, their tradition
says, this happened.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p10">22. Require it - Make inquisition for innocent blood. But
the words may be rendered, The Lord will look upon it, and require it,
will require satisfaction from you for it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p11">23. The year - So soon did God hear the cry of his holy
prophet's blood, and revenge it. The princes - That it might appear they
were sent and directed by God to single out to destruction the first
beginners of this general apostacy.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p12">25. Son - By which it seems, he slew not only Zechariah,
but his brothers also. Perhaps they that slew him intended to take
vengeance for that innocent blood. However that was it, which God
intended, in permitting them to do it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxv.ii-p13">27. Burdens - The great judgments of God upon him, both
by the Syrians, ver. xxiv, 23, and by great diseases, ver. 25.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXV" progress="70.08%" prev="ii.xv.xxv.ii" next="ii.xv.xxvi.i" id="ii.xv.xxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXV" id="ii.xv.xxvi-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|25|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.25" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxvi-p0.2">XXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXV" progress="70.08%" prev="ii.xv.xxvi" next="ii.xv.xxvi.ii" id="ii.xv.xxvi.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.i-p1">Amaziah revenges his father's death, ver. 1-4. Obeys the
command of God and dismisses the Israelites, 5-10. Conquers the
Edomites, ver. 11-13. Turns idolater and despises reproof, ver. 14- 16.
Challenges the king of Israel and suffers for it, ver. 17-24. Ends his
days ingloriously, ver. 25-28.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXV" progress="70.09%" prev="ii.xv.xxvi.i" next="ii.xv.xxvii" id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii-p1">2. But not, &amp;c. - He was not an enemy to religion,
but a cool and indifferent friend. He was not a man of serious piety;
for his heart was not whole with God.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii-p2">7. Let not, &amp;c. - It is comfortable to employ those,
who we have reason to hope, have an interest in heaven, but dangerous
associating with those from whom the Lord is departed.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii-p3">8. Do it - It is an ironical concession like that, go,
and prosper.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii-p4">10. Anger kindled - Because they were both disgraced by
this rejection, and disappointed of that spoil which they hoped to gain,
whereas now they are sent away empty; for the hundred talents probably
were given to their officers only to raise men for this service.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii-p5">13. Cities of Judah - Thus God chastised those cities of
Judah for their idolatries which were found most in the parts next to
Israel. The men of Israel had corrupted them, and now are a plague to
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii-p6">16. Art thou, &amp;c. - Who art thou that presumest to
direct my affairs, without my commission? The secure sinner perhaps
values himself on having silenced his reprovers and monitors. But what
comes of it? It is a plain indication he is marked out for ruin. They
that are deaf to reproof, are ripening apace for destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii-p7">17. Advice - About the injury which the Israelites had
done to his people, and how he should repair it. He took advice. But
with whom? Not with the prophet, but with his flattering statesmen. It
is good to take advice: but it should be of them who are fit to advise
us.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii-p8">20. Of God - Who gave him up to his own error and
passion, in order to his ruin.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvi.ii-p9">24. Obed-edom - With Obed-edom's posterity, to whom the
custody of the sacred treasures was committed.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVI" progress="70.12%" prev="ii.xv.xxvi.ii" next="ii.xv.xxvii.i" id="ii.xv.xxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXVI" id="ii.xv.xxvii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|26|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.26" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxvii-p0.2">XXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVI" progress="70.12%" prev="ii.xv.xxvii" next="ii.xv.xxvii.ii" id="ii.xv.xxvii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxvii.i-p1">Uzziah reigns well, ver. 1-5. Prospers in his wars,
building, and the affairs of his kingdom, ver. 6-15. Invading the
priest's office, is struck with a leprosy, ver. 16-20. Is confined to
his death, ver. 21-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVI" progress="70.12%" prev="ii.xv.xxvii.i" next="ii.xv.xxviii" id="ii.xv.xxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxvii.ii-p1">10. Towers - To guard his cattle from the inroads which
the Arabians were accustomed to make: and to give notice of the approach
of any enemy.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvii.ii-p2">16. Into Jerusalem - Into the holy place, where the altar
of incense stood, and into which none but the priests might enter, much
less offer incense.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvii.ii-p3">18. Withstood - Hebrew. stood up against Uzziah, not by
force, or laying hands upon him to restrain him, for in the next verse
you still find the censer in his hand; but only by admonition and
reproof, which follows. Neither, &amp;c. - Expect that God will punish
thee, or put some brand of infamy upon thee for this presumption. But
this they express modestly, because they considered that he to whom they
spake, though an offender, was their sovereign.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvii.ii-p4">19. His forehead - So that he could not hide his shame:
though it is probable it was also in the rest of his body. From beside -
By a stroke from an invisible hand coming from the altar; that he might
be assured this was the effect of God's displeasure.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvii.ii-p5">20. Thrust - Not by force, which needed not, for he
voluntarily hasted away, as it follows; but by vehement persuasions and
denunciations of God's farther judgments upon him, if he did not
depart.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxvii.ii-p6">21. His death - God would have this leprosy to be
incurable, as a lasting monument of his anger against such presumptuous
invaders of the priest's office. Dwelt, &amp;c. - As he was obliged to
do by law, which he durst not now resist, being under the hand of God,
and under the fear of worse plagues, if he did not so. For - He dwelt in
a several house, because he might not come into the temple or courts,
nor consequently into any publick assembly. So the punishment answered
the sin, as face does to face in a glass. He thrust himself into the
temple of God, whether the priests only had admission: and for that was
thrust out of the very courts of the temple, into which the meanest of,
his subjects might enter. He invaded the dignity of the priesthood, to
which he had no right, and is for that deprived of the royal dignity, to
which he had an undoubted right.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVII" progress="70.16%" prev="ii.xv.xxvii.ii" next="ii.xv.xxviii.i" id="ii.xv.xxviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXVII" id="ii.xv.xxviii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|27|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.27" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxviii-p0.2">XXVII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVII" progress="70.16%" prev="ii.xv.xxviii" next="ii.xv.xxviii.ii" id="ii.xv.xxviii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxviii.i-p1">Jotham reigns well and prospers, ver. 1-6. The conclusion
of his reign, ver. 7-9.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVII" progress="70.16%" prev="ii.xv.xxviii.i" next="ii.xv.xxix" id="ii.xv.xxviii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxviii.ii-p1">2. He did - He did according to all that his father
Uzziah did; except in his miscarriages. We must not imitate those we
have the greatest esteem for, any farther than we do well; but their
failings must be warnings to us, to walk more circumspectly.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxviii.ii-p2">3. Built - Repaired it: for it was built before, chap.
xi, 5.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXVIII" progress="70.17%" prev="ii.xv.xxviii.ii" next="ii.xv.xxix.i" id="ii.xv.xxix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXVIII" id="ii.xv.xxix-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|28|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.28" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxix-p0.2">XXVIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXVIII" progress="70.17%" prev="ii.xv.xxix" next="ii.xv.xxix.ii" id="ii.xv.xxix.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.i-p1">Ahaz reigns ill, ver. 1-4. Is smitten by the Syrians and
Israelites, ver. 5-8. who send back the captives they had taken, ver.
9-15. Ahaz sends for help to the king of Asyria, but in vain, ver.
16-21. Yet he continues in idolatry, ver. 22-25. and dies, ver. 26,
27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXVIII" progress="70.17%" prev="ii.xv.xxix.i" next="ii.xv.xxx" id="ii.xv.xxix.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p1">5. His God - God was his God, tho' not by special
relation, (which Ahaz had renounced) yet by his sovereign dominion over
him: for God did not forfeit his right by Ahaz's denying it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p2">6. Forsaken - Ahaz walked in the ways of the kings of
Israel, and God chose the king of Israel for his scourge: it is just
with God, to make them a plague to us, whom we have made our patterns,
or partners in sin.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p3">9. A rage - An unbounded rage, which cries to God for
vengeance, against such bloody men.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p4">10. To keep under - It ill becomes sinners to be cruel.
Shew mercy to them, for you are undone, unless God shew you mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p5">14. Left the captives - And herein they shewed a more
truly heroic bravery, than they did in taking them. It is true honour
for a man to yield to reason and religion even in spite of interest.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p6">15. Were expressed - Who were appointed to take care
about the management of this business.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p7">16. Kings - Princes, who may be called kings in a more
general signification of the word.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p8">19. Low - As high as they were before in wealth and
power. They that will not humble themselves under the word of God will
be humbled by his judgments. Naked - Taking away their ornament and
their defense and strength, namely their treasures, which he sent to the
Assyrian to no purpose; their frontier towns, and other strong holds,
which by his folly and wickedness were lost; their religion, and the
Divine protection, which was their great and only firm security.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p9">20. Distressed - Or, straitened him, by robbing him of
his treasures. Strengthened not - A most emphatical expression: for tho'
he weakened his present enemy the Syrian, yet all things considered, he
did not strengthen Ahaz and his kingdom, but weaken them; for by
removing the Syrian, who, tho' a troublesome neighbour, was a kind of
bulwark to him, he smoothed the way for himself, a far more dangerous
enemy, as appears in the very next king's reign.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxix.ii-p10">22. That Ahaz - That monster and reproach of mankind,
that unteachable and incorrigible prince, whom even grievous afflictions
made worse, which commonly make men better. This is he, whose name
deserves to be remembered and detested forever.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXIX" progress="70.21%" prev="ii.xv.xxix.ii" next="ii.xv.xxx.i" id="ii.xv.xxx">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXIX" id="ii.xv.xxx-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|29|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.29" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxx-p0.2">XXIX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXIX" progress="70.21%" prev="ii.xv.xxx" next="ii.xv.xxx.ii" id="ii.xv.xxx.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.i-p1">Hezekiah's exhortation to the priests and Levites, ver.
1-11. The care of the Levites to cleanse the temple and put things into
order, ver. 12-19. A solemn revival of God's ordinances, ver. 20-
36.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXIX" progress="70.21%" prev="ii.xv.xxx.i" next="ii.xv.xxxi" id="ii.xv.xxx.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p1">4. And he brought in,&amp;c. - He found Judah low and
naked, yet did not make it his first business to revive the civil
interests of his kingdom, but to restore religion to a good posture.
Those that begin with God, begin at the right end of their work; and it
will prosper accordingly.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p2">5. Filthiness - That filthy altar, which Ahaz had put in
the place of God's altar, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xvi. 11" id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Kgs|16|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.16.11">2 Kings xvi, 11</scripRef>, and the idols, or other abominable things which were
there.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p3">6. Turned, &amp;c. - They have wilfully and obstinately
forsaken God and his worship; that posture being a signification of
contempt.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p4">7. They - He saith not, my father, because it became him
as a son, to be as tender as might be of his father's name: and because
his father would not have done all this, if their fathers had not
neglected their duty.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p5">8. Hissing - To such calamities as all that see and hear
of, shall be astonished at, and hiss at those, who by their own sin and
folly have brought such miseries upon themselves. When we are under the
rebukes of God's providence, it is good for us to inquire, Whether we
have not neglected God's ordinances, and whether that be not the
controversy he has with us?</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p6">9. Captivity - Tho' they were presently released, chap.
xxviii, 5, 14, 15.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p7">11. Sons - So he calls them, though many of them were
elder than himself, because he was by his tender love and affection, as
he was by his office obliged to be, a nursing father to them. Negligent
- In sanctifying yourselves and the temple, ver. 5, and in quickening
and preparing yourselves and the people for God's service.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p8">15. To cleanse - From the dirt it had contracted, while
it was so long shut up; from dust, cobwebs, and the rust of the vessels.
Much more from the idols, and idolatrous altars which had been set up
therein.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p9">17. The first day - A happy beginning of the new year!
Thus should every year begin with the reformation of what is amiss, and
the purging away of all the defilements contracted the foregoing
year.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p10">19. Sanctified - Tho' the vessels of the sanctuary may be
profaned for a while, God will find a time and a way to sanctify them.
Neither his ordinances nor his obedient people, shall be suffered to
fail forever.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p11">21. Seven - The number seven is customary in sacred
matters, and is here used in regard of the vast numbers and various
kinds of sins, the guilt whereof yet lay upon the kingdom, which was now
to be expiated. Indeed, in case of one particular sin of ignorance done
by the people, there was but one bullock to be offered, but here the
sins were many and presumptuous. Kingdom - To make atonement for the
sins of the king and the royal family, and the court. Sanctuary - For
all the idolatry and uncleanness wherewith the temple had been polluted.
They thought it not enough to lament and forsake their sins, but they
brought a sin-offering. Even our repentance and reformation will not
obtain pardon, but thro' Christ, who was made sin, that is, a
sin-offering for us.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p12">23. They laid - The king and the elders of the
congregation in the name of the whole congregation.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p13">27. The song - The psalms composed by David and Asaph.
Even sorrow for sin must not put us out of tune for praising God. By
faith we must even then rejoice in the Lord our righteousness, and our
prayers and praises must attend with his offering, to be accepted only
in the virtue of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p14">31. Consecrated - Now that you have reconciled yourselves
and the house to God, and that he is willing and ready to accept your
sacrifices. Burnt-offerings - Wherein there was more generosity than in
the other sacrifices, because they were wholly burnt and offered to
God.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p15">33. Consecrated things - All the offerings consecrated to
God, besides the burnt-offerings already mentioned.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p16">34. Too few - Such as were sanctified and fit for their
work, as the following words shew: for otherwise the number of the
priests was more than sufficient for this employment. Burnt-offerings -
And much less all the other sacrifices, which were more numerous; the
slaying whereof was the priests proper work. The Levites - Necessity
excusing their deviation from the rule.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxx.ii-p17">36. Rejoiced - It was, as a very great, so a sudden
change, that the people, who but the other day were so ready to comply
with wicked Ahaz in his idolatrous presumptions, were now so free and
forward in God's service: whereby it plainly appeared to be the work of
God, changing their hearts by his Holy Spirit.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXX" progress="70.29%" prev="ii.xv.xxx.ii" next="ii.xv.xxxi.i" id="ii.xv.xxxi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXX" id="ii.xv.xxxi-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|30|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.30" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxxi-p0.2">XXX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXX" progress="70.29%" prev="ii.xv.xxxi" next="ii.xv.xxxi.ii" id="ii.xv.xxxi.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.i-p1">The king and people resolve to keep the passover, ver.
1-5. He invites Judah and Israel to it, ver. 6-12. The joyful
celebration of it, ver. 13-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXX" progress="70.29%" prev="ii.xv.xxxi.i" next="ii.xv.xxxii" id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p1">1. Israel - All the persons of the ten tribes, who were
settled in his kingdom. Ephraim, &amp;c. - To all the remainder of the
ten tribes, ver. 5, here expressed by the names of Ephraim and Manasseh,
as elsewhere by the name of Ephraim only. But he names these two tribes,
because they were nearest to his kingdom, and a great number of them had
long since, and from time to time joined themselves to the kingdom of
Judah, chap. xv, 8, 9. At Jerusalem - Admonishing them of their duty to
God, and persuading them to comply with it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p2">2. Second month - Which was against the common rule, but
the doing of this in its proper time, namely, the fourteenth day of the
first month was impossible, because the temple was not cleansed, nor
they prepared. As there was a proviso in the law, that particular
persons who were unclean in the first month, might keep the passover the
fourteenth day of the second month, he doubted not but that might be
extended by the whole congregation.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p3">3. They kept - Not in the same manner as they had done
the former, V. 3. Sufficiently - In such manner as was fit, nor in such
numbers as but in the solemn worship of God, by sacrifices, and prayers,
and praise, were necessary for the slaying and offering of so many
thousands of and publick instruction of that great congregation in the
good knowledge paschal-offerings, as appears, because they were not
sufficient for of the Lord; which was most necessary for the people
after so long and those offerings, which were comparatively few, chap.
xxix, 32, 33, 34. dismal a night of ignorance, superstition and
idolatry.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p4">10. They - The generality of the ten tribes; who by long
want of meat had now lost their appetite to God's ordinances, for which
they paid dear. For about six years after their refusal of this offer of
grace they were all carried away captive, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xviii. 1, 10" id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|2Kgs|18|1|0|0;|2Kgs|18|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.18.1 Bible:2Kgs.18.10">2 Kings xviii, 1, 10</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p5">12. The hand of God - God by the power of his grace
inclined their hearts to an unanimous compliance with God's and the
king's will. And this is mentioned as the reason of this wonderful
change wrought in these men, who had lately been given up to
idolatry.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p6">15. Ashamed - Their negligence and remissness being
upbraided by the general forwardness of the people. The zeal which we
observe in others, should make us ashamed of our own coldness, and
quicken us not only to do our duty, but to do it with our might.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p7">19. The sanctuary - With that purification which was
required of them that came in God's sanctuary. So he calls it to
distinguish from that internal purity which they are here acknowledged
to have. The great thing required in our attendance on God's ordinances
is, that we prepare our heart to seek him; that the inward man be
engaged, that we make heart work of it. All is nothing without this.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p8">20. Healed - That is, pardoned this their sin, and
accepting them and their services, as if they had been clean.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p9">22. Spoke comfortably - Encouraged them to a chearful and
diligent attendance upon their holy ministrations. Princes and
magistrates by encouraging faithful and labourious preachers, greatly
promote the kingdom of God. That taught - Who by their office were to
instruct and build up the people in the knowledge and fear of God: which
is mentioned as the cause of his respect and kindness to them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p10">24. Did give - First to God, to whom the parts appointed
were offered in a way of thanksgiving; and then to the people, who
feasted upon the relicks, as the offerer used to do in peace- offerings:
and Hezekiah, who was the offerer, gave away his right in the remains of
the sacrifices to the people. Which generosity is the more considerable,
because it was in the beginning of his reign, when he found the
exchequer empty; and when he had been at great expense about cleansing
and refitting the temple, and making preparations for this great
feast.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxi.ii-p11">27. The Levites - Those of the Levites who were priests
also; for to them only this work belonged.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXI" progress="70.36%" prev="ii.xv.xxxi.ii" next="ii.xv.xxxii.i" id="ii.xv.xxxii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXXI" id="ii.xv.xxxii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|31|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.31" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxxii-p0.2">XXXI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXI" progress="70.36%" prev="ii.xv.xxxii" next="ii.xv.xxxii.ii" id="ii.xv.xxxii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.i-p1">The remains of idolatry are destroyed, ver. 1. Hezekiah
provides work and maintenance for the priests and Levites, ver. 2- 4.
The people bring in their dues abundantly, ver. 5-10. Officers are
appointed to dispose of them, ver. 11-19. Hezekiah's sincerity, ver. 20,
21.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXI" progress="70.37%" prev="ii.xv.xxxii.i" next="ii.xv.xxxiii" id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p1">1. Manasseh - By the special impulse and direction of
God's spirit. And he knew Hoshea contented himself with the worship of
the calves, and did not practice that great idolatry which his
predecessors had used, and therefore would patiently suffer the breaking
of the images of Baal, and the things belonging to them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p2">2. The tents - Within the gates of the house of the Lord:
which is here called tents, because the host of the Lord, the priests
and Levites, encamped there. And perhaps to intimate, that it was
shortly to be removed.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p3">3. Of his substance - Which had hitherto been taken out
of the treasures of the temple, but that he might ease the people in
their present poverty, which his predecessor had brought upon them, and
engage them to a more chearful attendance upon God's service, he took
the burden upon himself.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p4">4. Encouraged - Freed them from worldly cares and
distractions, and enabled to give up themselves entirely to the serious
study of God's law, and to the instruction, and direction, and
quickening of the people.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p5">5. Came abroad - As Soon as the king extended that
command to all the parts of his kingdom, which, ver. 4, was confined to
them that dwelt in Jerusalem. Honey - Or, dates, as the Hebrew writers
generally, understand this word, which were given to them, because of
the sweetness of their taste in some sort resembling honey. For the law
requires no tithes, but of the fruits of trees, or of the earth, or of
beasts.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p6">6. By heaps - What the priests and the Levites had
occasion for, they made use of, and the overplus was laid in heaps.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p7">7. Third month - Of the sacred year, in which their
harvest began. Seventh - In which their harvest ended and the feast of
tabernacles was kept.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p8">8. Blessed the Lord - Both for giving such plentiful
provisions to his land and for giving his people such liberal hearts.
And they praised the people for their forwardness and faithfulness in
it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p9">9. Questioned - How it came to pass that no more of their
provision was spent and that there yet remained such great heaps of
it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p10">14. Most holy things - The remainders of the
freewill-offering, the sin-offering, and trespass-offering, and the
shew-bread; to see that all had a competent maintenance for themselves
and their families.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p11">15. And next, &amp;c. - These were intrusted with
receiving and distributing the several portions belonging to the priests
who abode in their several cities, whilst their brethren came up to
Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxii.ii-p12">18. For, &amp;c. - This is alleged as a reason why their
wives and children were provided for out of the holy things, because
they sequestered themselves from worldly affairs, by which they might
otherwise have provided for their families.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXII" progress="70.42%" prev="ii.xv.xxxii.ii" next="ii.xv.xxxiii.i" id="ii.xv.xxxiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXXII" id="ii.xv.xxxiii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|32|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.32" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxxiii-p0.2">XXXII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXII" progress="70.42%" prev="ii.xv.xxxiii" next="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii" id="ii.xv.xxxiii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiii.i-p1">Sennacherib invading Judah, Hezekiah fortifies himself,
ver. 1-8. The insolent letters and messages sent by Sennacherib, ver.
9-19. The destruction of his army, ver. 20-23. Hezekiah's sickness,
riches, and death, ver. 24-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXII" progress="70.42%" prev="ii.xv.xxxiii.i" next="ii.xv.xxxiv" id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p1">1. After, &amp;c. - An emphatical preface, signifying,
that notwithstanding all his zeal for God, God saw fit to exercise him
with a sore trial. And God ordered it at this time, that he might have
an opportunity of shewing himself strong, on the behalf of his returning
people. It is possible, we may be in the way of our duty, and yet meet
with trouble and danger. God permits this, for the trial of our
confidence in him, and the manifestation of his care over us.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p2">3. To stop - And withal to draw the waters by secret
pipes underground to Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p3">21. The Lord sent an angel - The Jewish comment says the
word of the Lord sent Gabriel to do this execution, and that it done
with lightning, and in the passover night, the same night wherein the
first-born in Egypt were slain.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p4">25. Lifted up - For that prodigious victory over the
Assyrians, for his miraculous restoration from sickness, and for the
honour since done him by an embassy from the great king of Babylon. All
which probably raised in him too great an opinion of himself, as if
these things were done for his piety and virtues.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p5">29. Provided - He repaired, fortified, and beautified
them for the honour and safety of his kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p6">30. Stopped, &amp;c. - A rivulet near Jerusalem
consisting of two streams, the upper which was brought into one pool,
called the upper pool, <scripRef passage="Isaiah vii. 3" id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Isa|7|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.7.3">Isaiah vii, 3</scripRef>, and the lower which was brought into another, called the
lower pool, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xxii. 9" id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Isa|22|9|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.22.9">Isaiah xxii, 9</scripRef>. The former he diverted and brought by pipes into Jerusalem,
which was a work of great art and labour.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p7">31. Wonder that was done - Either the destruction of the
Assyrians, or the going back of the sun. These miracles were wrought to
alarm and awaken a stupid, careless world, and to turn them from dumb
and lame idols to the living God. God left him - To himself, and
suffered Satan to try him; that he might know he had infirmities and
sins as well as virtues. O what need have great men, and good men, and
useful men, to study their own follies and infirmities, and to beg
earnestly of God, that he would hide pride from them!</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii-p8">33. Did him honour - It is a debt we owe to those who
have been eminently useful, to do them honour at their death, when they
are out of the reach of flattery, and we have seen the end of their
conversation.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIII" progress="70.46%" prev="ii.xv.xxxiii.ii" next="ii.xv.xxxiv.i" id="ii.xv.xxxiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXXIII" id="ii.xv.xxxiv-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|33|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.33" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxxiv-p0.2">XXXIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXIII" progress="70.46%" prev="ii.xv.xxxiv" next="ii.xv.xxxiv.ii" id="ii.xv.xxxiv.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiv.i-p1">The wicked reign of Manasseh, ver. 1-10. His captivity,
prayer, and reformation, ver. 11-17. The conclusion of his reign, ver.
18-20. The wicked reign and death of Amon, ver. 21-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXIII" progress="70.46%" prev="ii.xv.xxxiv.i" next="ii.xv.xxxv" id="ii.xv.xxxiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiv.ii-p1">11. To Babylon - The king of Babylon is here called the
king of Assyria, because he had added Assyria to his empire, who having
been informed by his ambassadors of the great riches which were in
Hezekiah's treasures at Jerusalem, and being assured of Manasseh's
degeneracy from the piety of his father, and from that God whose power
alone made Hezekiah formidable, he thought this a fit season to invade
Manasseh's kingdom. The Jews say, in the twenty second year of his
reign.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiv.ii-p2">12. Besought - It becomes sinners to humble themselves
before that God, whom they have offended. It becomes sufferers to humble
themselves before him that corrects them, and to accept of the
punishment of their iniquity.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiv.ii-p3">17. Still - Manasseh could not carry the reformation so
far as he had carried the corruption. It is an easy thing to debauch
men's manners; but not so easy to reform them again.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiv.ii-p4">18. Of Israel - Of Judah, often called Israel, he speaks
not of the book of Kings, for these things are not mentioned there, but
of their publick records, whence the most important things were taken by
the prophets, and put into those canonical books.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxiv.ii-p5">19. Hosai - A writer so called.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXIV" progress="70.48%" prev="ii.xv.xxxiv.ii" next="ii.xv.xxxv.i" id="ii.xv.xxxv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXXIV" id="ii.xv.xxxv-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|34|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.34" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxxv-p0.2">XXXIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXIV" progress="70.48%" prev="ii.xv.xxxv" next="ii.xv.xxxv.ii" id="ii.xv.xxxv.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxv.i-p1">The general character of Josiah, ver. 1, 2. He roots out
idolatry, ver. 3-7. Repairs the temple, ver. 8-13. Rends his clothes on
hearing the book of the law, and sends to inquire of God, ver. 14-22.
Huldah foretells the destruction of Jerusalem, ver. 23-28. Josiah and
the people renew their covenant with God, ver. 29-33.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXIV" progress="70.49%" prev="ii.xv.xxxv.i" next="ii.xv.xxxvi" id="ii.xv.xxxv.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxv.ii-p1">3. Young - ln the sixteenth year of his age; when he was
entering into the age of temptation, and had the administration of his
kingdom wholly in his own power, and none to restrain him; even then he
begins to be religious in good earnest.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxv.ii-p2">6. Naphtali - Which was in the utmost borders of the
kingdom of Israel. For it must be remembered, that the ten tribes were
now gone into captivity; and those who were come in their stead were
weak and few, and not able to withstand the power of Josiah.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxv.ii-p3">8. The house - The house of God, called the house by way
of eminency.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxv.ii-p4">11. Houses - The chambers joining to the temple.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxv.ii-p5">12. Musick - All these here named, were skilful in
instruments of musick. Which may be here mentioned, to intimate, that as
they were skilful, so they were exercised in both employments, and did
successively oversee the work, and praise God with their voices and
instruments.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxv.ii-p6">19. Rent his clothes - Were the things contained in
scripture new to us, as they were here to Josiah, surely they would make
deeper impressions upon us than they commonly do. But they are not the
less weighty, and therefore should not be the less regarded, because
they are well known.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxv.ii-p7">32. To stand to it - He caused them to engage by an oath
or covenant, that they would observe the laws of God, as his
predecessors had formerly done, and which indeed they were before
obliged to do.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxv.ii-p8">33. Even to serve - The repetition shews, that this was
the only thing his heart was set upon. He aimed at nothing in all he
did, but to engage them to God and their duty.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXV" progress="70.52%" prev="ii.xv.xxxv.ii" next="ii.xv.xxxvi.i" id="ii.xv.xxxvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXXV" id="ii.xv.xxxvi-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|35|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.35" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxxvi-p0.2">XXXV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXV" progress="70.52%" prev="ii.xv.xxxvi" next="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii" id="ii.xv.xxxvi.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.i-p1">Josiah keeps a solemn passover, ver. 1-19. He goes
against Pharaoh-necho, and is slain, ver, 20-24. He is bitterly
lamented, ver. 25-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXV" progress="70.52%" prev="ii.xv.xxxvi.i" next="ii.xv.xxxvii" id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p1">3. The house - In the holy of holies. Whence, it may
seem, it had been removed, by some of the wicked kings of Judah,
possibly by Josiah's father Amon. A burden - Or, that it might not be a
burden, so these words are to be joined with the former, as the reason
why Solomon built this house, that the ark might have a constant and
fixed habitation, and not need to be carried from place to place upon
their shoulders, as it had been done while it was in the tabernacle.
Ministers must look upon themselves as servants both to Christ, and to
the people, for his sake. They must take care and take pains, and lay
themselves out to the utmost, both for the honour and glory of God, and
for the benefit of his people, not as having dominion over their faith,
but as helpers of their holiness and joy.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p2">5. Stand - Or, minister, (as that word is frequently
used) in the court of the priests. According - According to the several
families both of the people, whom he calls their brethren, lest they
should despise them, or grudge to serve them, and of the Levites. For
the passover was to be eaten by the several families according to their
numbers, and therefore he commands these persons, that when the paschal
lambs were brought to them to be killed, they might so order the matter,
that they might be distributed to the several families whether of the
Levitical or other tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p3">8. Princes - Not the political, but ecclesiastical
princes, or the chief of the priests and Levites, whose names here
follow. Levites - For the use of any of the families of them, as need
should be. For they supposed the thirty thousand which the king had
given were not sufficient for all the families.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p4">12. Removed - Some of the lesser cattle; for these also
might be offered as burnt-offerings, <scripRef passage="Lev. i. 10" id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Lev|1|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.1.10">Lev. i, 10</scripRef>, and hence it may seem that all these small cattle were not
given for paschal-lambs, but were to be offered as burnt-offerings for
the people. And these they put apart lest they should be confounded with
them which were for another use; and, that they might not be hindered
from that which was their present work, that they might give, the
paschal-lambs or kids. To offer - These words may belong to the last
words, and to the paschal-lambs, which they were first to offer to the
Lord, by killing them and sprinkling the blood, and then to give to the
people; though the giving be here mentioned before the offering, such
transpositions being usual in scripture. Oxen - As they did with the
lesser cattle; they removed those oxen which were to be offered as
burnt-offerings, from those which were to be offered as
peace-offerings.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p5">18. Like to that - The whole solemnity was performed
exactly according to the law, whereas in Hezekiah's passover there were
several irregularities: likewise Josiah furnished the whole congregation
with beasts for sacrifice at his own charge, which no king ever did
before him.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p6">20. After all - When he and his people hoped that God was
reconciled, and the foundation of a lasting happiness laid, their hopes
were quickly blasted. So much are men often mistaken in their judgments
about the designs of God's providence.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p7">21. The house - Against the house of the king of Assyria,
between whom and me there is war. It is at thy peril, if thou engage
against one who has both a better army, and a better cause and God on
his side.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p8">22. Hearkened not - How can we think to prosper in our
ways, if we do not acknowledge God in them!</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii-p9">25. To this day - In all their succeeding Lamentations
for their publick calamities, they remembered Josiah's death as their
first and fatal blow, which opened the flood-gates to all their
following miseries.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XXXVI" progress="70.58%" prev="ii.xv.xxxvi.ii" next="ii.xv.xxxvii.i" id="ii.xv.xxxvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="2 Chron. XXXVI" id="ii.xv.xxxvii-p0.1" parsed="|2Chr|36|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Chr.36" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xv.xxxvii-p0.2">XXXVI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XXXVI" progress="70.58%" prev="ii.xv.xxxvii" next="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii" id="ii.xv.xxxvii.i">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvii.i-p1">The wicked reign of Jehoahaz, ver. 1-4. Jehoiakim, ver.
5-8. Jehoiachin and Zedekiah, ver. 9-13. The wickedness of the people,
ver. 14-16. Jerusalem destroyed, Judah laid waste, the people slain or
led away captive, according to God's word, ver. 17-21. The proclamation
of Cyrus, ver. 22, 23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XXXVI" progress="70.59%" prev="ii.xv.xxxvii.i" next="ii.xvi" id="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii">

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii-p1">8. Found in him - That crime of rebellion against the
king of Babylon, which for a time he kept in his own breast, but when he
saw fit, discovered it, and was convicted of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii-p2">10. Expired - Hebrew. at the return of the year: at the
beginning of the next year, according to the sacred account of the
Hebrew, at the spring of the year, the time when kings go forth to
battle, as is elsewhere said, when Nebuchadnezzar, among others, went
forth to settle and enlarge his conquests. His brother - Largely so
called, for this was his uncle, or his father's brother, being the son
of Josiah.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii-p3">13. By God - Who had required him to swear fealty and
constant obedience to him by the true God, whom he called upon to be a
witness against him if he broke his oath. So his rebellion was
aggravated with perjury, and horrid contempt of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii-p4">15. Rising - Sending them early and diligently, as a
careful house- holder, who rises betimes about his business. God sent
them many prophets and messages, some at the very beginning of their
apostacy, and others afterward, 'till the very day of their
captivity.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii-p5">16. No remedy - Because the people would not repent, and
God would not pardon them.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii-p6">17. Chaldees - Abraham was called out of Ur of the
Chaldees, when God took him into covenant with himself. And now his
degenerate seed are carried into that country again, to signify that
they had forfeited all that kindness wherewith they had been loved for
their father's sake, and the benefit of the covenant into which he was
called.</p>

<p id="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii-p7">21. Sabbaths - Had rested from the labour of the
husbandman in plowing and harrowing it; the people that should have
managed it being destroyed. Many a time had they ploughed and sowed
their land in the seventh year, when it should have rested: and now it
lay unploughed and unsown for ten times seven years. Yet even this might
encourage them to hope, that they should in due time return to it again.
Had others come and taken possession of it, they might have despaired of
ever recovering it. But while it lay desolate, it, as it were, waited
for them, and refused to acknowledge any other owners.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE BOOK OF EZRA" progress="70.63%" prev="ii.xv.xxxvii.ii" next="ii.xvi.i" id="ii.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra" id="ii.xvi-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.xvi-p0.2">NOTES ON THE BOOK OF EZRA</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Ezra" progress="70.63%" prev="ii.xvi" next="ii.xvi.ii" id="ii.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.i-p1">THE history of this book is the accomplishment of
Jeremiah's prophecy, concerning the return of the Jews out of Babylon,
at the end of seventy years, and a type of the accomplishment of the
prophecies in the Revelation, touching the deliverance of the Gospel
Church from Spiritual Babylon. Ezra preserved the records of that great
revolution, and transmitted them to the church in this book. It gives us
an account of the Jews return from their captivity, chap. 1, 2. Of the
building of the temple, notwithstanding the opposition it met with,
chap. 3-6. Of Ezra's coming to Jerusalem, chap. 7, 8. Of his obliging
those that had married strange wives to put them away, chap. 9, 10.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="70.64%" prev="ii.xvi.i" next="ii.xvi.ii.i" id="ii.xvi.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra I" id="ii.xvi.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="70.64%" prev="ii.xvi.ii" next="ii.xvi.ii.ii" id="ii.xvi.ii.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.ii.i-p1">The proclamation of Cyrus, for the release of the Jews,
and building of the temple, ver. 1-4. The return of many of them, ver.
5, 6. Orders given for restoring the vessels of the temple, ver. 7-
11.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="70.64%" prev="ii.xvi.ii.i" next="ii.xvi.iii" id="ii.xvi.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.ii.ii-p1">1. Fulfilled - Nebuchadnezzar carried many of the Jews
into captivity in the first year of his reign (the fourth of Jehoiakim).
He reigned forty-five years, his son Evil-merodach twenty-three, and his
grandson Belshazzar, three years, which make up the seventy years
foretold by Jeremiah. First year - Of his reign in Babylon: for he had
been king of Persia for many years.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ii.ii-p2">2. All, &amp;c. - In those parts of the world; all that
vast empire formerly under the Assyrians and Babylonians. The gift of
which he ascribes to the great God; by that express prophecy of Isaiah
concerning him, <scripRef passage="Isaiah xliv. 28" id="ii.xvi.ii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Isa|44|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Isa.44.28">Isaiah xliv, 28</scripRef>; xlv, 1, 13, so long before he was born; which prophecy the
Jews had doubtlessly shewed him, which also carried a great evidence
with it, especially to him who was so highly encouraged by it: or by a
special illumination which God vouchsafed to him, as he did to
Nebuchadnezzar and Darius, and some other Heathen princes.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ii.ii-p3">5. Then rose up, &amp;c. - These being a new generation,
went out like their father Abraham, from this land of the Chaldees, not
knowing whither they went.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ii.ii-p4">6. Strengthened their hands - God can, when he pleases,
incline the hearts of strangers to be kind to his people; yea, make
those strengthen their hands, who formerly weakened them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ii.ii-p5">8. Sheshbazzar - Zerubbabel; the Chaldeans called him
Sheshbazzar, that is, Joy in tribulation, but among his own people he
was called Zerubbabel, a stranger in Babylon. So he looked upon himself,
tho' (Josephus says) he was captain of the life- guard.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="70.67%" prev="ii.xvi.ii.ii" next="ii.xvi.iii.i" id="ii.xvi.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra II" id="ii.xvi.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="70.67%" prev="ii.xvi.iii" next="ii.xvi.iii.ii" id="ii.xvi.iii.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.i-p1">The leaders that returned, ver. 1, 2. The people, ver.
3-35 The priests, Levites and retainers to the temple, ver. 36-63. The
sum total and their substance, ver. 64-67. Their offerings, ver.
68-70.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="70.67%" prev="ii.xvi.iii.i" next="ii.xvi.iv" id="ii.xvi.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p1">1. The province - Of Judah, called a province, chap. v,
8. And he calls it thus emphatically to mind himself and his brethren of
that sad change which their sins had made among them, that from an
illustrious, independent, and formidable kingdom, were fallen to be an
obscure, servile, and contemptible province, first under the Chaldeans,
and now under the Persians.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p2">2. Who came, &amp;c. - This catalogue, differs in some
names and numbers from that <scripRef passage="Neh. vii. 6-64" id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Neh|7|6|7|64" osisRef="Bible:Neh.7.6-Neh.7.64">Neh. vii, 6-64</scripRef>, which might be because several names were given to the same
persons; and because of the many changes which might happen in the same
families between the time of the first making of this catalogue by Ezra,
and the making it anew so many years after.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p3">3. The children - The posterity, as that word is
constantly taken in this catalogue. Of Parosh - That descend either from
Parosh, or from that family whereof Parosh was the chief. And so for the
rest.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p4">5. Seven hundred, &amp;c. - In <scripRef passage="Neh. vii. 10" id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Neh|7|10|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.7.10">Neh. vii, 10</scripRef>, they were only six hundred and fifty two, it seems seven
hundred and seventy five marched out of Babylon, but some of them died,
others were hindered by sickness, or other casualties, and so there came
only six hundred and fifty two to Jerusalem. And the like is to be said
in the like differences: which it suffices to hint once for all.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p5">21. Beth-lehem - And so these were the remainders of the
inhabitants of that city. (And the like may be said of the two following
names, Netophah and Anathoth, or others of the like nature.) So little
was Beth-lehem among the thousands of Judah! Yet thence must the Messiah
arise.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p6">39. Harim - The head of one of the twenty four courses
which David appointed, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xxiv. 8" id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|1Chr|24|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.24.8">1 Chron. xxiv, 8</scripRef>, of all which courses, some observe here are not above four
or five that returned. There is another Harim mentioned above, ver. 32,
but that was no priest, as this was ver. 36.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p7">43. Nethinims - Persons devoted to the inferior services
of the priests and Levites. Commonly supposed to be the Gibeonites,
given, (so their name signifies) by Joshua first, and again by David,
when Saul had expelled them, to the priests and Levites, for those
services.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p8">55. Servants - Who had lived in Solomon's family, and
after his death, called themselves and their families by that name,
esteeming it a great honour that they had been servants to so great a
prince.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p9">62. Genealogy - The Jews were generally very exact in
their genealogies from their own choice and interest, that they might
preserve the distinctions of the several tribes and families, which was
necessary both to make out their titles to offices or inheritances, and
to govern themselves thereby in the matter of marriages, and from the
special providence of God, that so it might be certainly known of what
tribe and family the Messiah was born.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p10">63. Tirshatha - The governor, Zerubbabel. With Urim,
&amp;c. - That this point which could not be found out by human skill,
might be determined by Divine direction. Hereby it appears that the Urim
and Thummim were lost in the destruction of the city and temple, tho'
the Jews fed themselves with hopes of recovering them, but in vain. And
by the want of that oracle, they were taught to expect the great oracle,
the Messiah.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p11">64. The whole, &amp;c. - The particular sums here
recited, come only to twenty and nine thousand eight hundred and
eighteen. Unto whom are added in this total sum twelve thousand five
hundred and forty two. Which, either were of the other tribes beside
Judah and Benjamin: or were such as were supposed to be Israelites, but
could not prove their pedigree by their genealogies.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p12">65. Women - For women as well as men were employed in
this exercise in the temple-service.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p13">68. The house - That is, to the ruins of the house; or to
the place were it stood.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p14">69. Sixty one thousand drams - Sixty one thousand drams
of gold amount to something more than so many pounds of our money. So
bishop Cumberland, who likewise supposes five thousand pounds of silver,
to be about thirty seven thousand pounds sterling.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iii.ii-p15">70. And all Israel in their cities - And they dwelt in
peace, in perfect harmony, a blessed presage of their settlement, as
their discord in the latter times of that state, was of their ruin.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="70.75%" prev="ii.xvi.iii.ii" next="ii.xvi.iv.i" id="ii.xvi.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra III" id="ii.xvi.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="70.75%" prev="ii.xvi.iv" next="ii.xvi.iv.ii" id="ii.xvi.iv.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.i-p1">They set up the altar, offer sacrifices thereon, and keep
the feasts, ver. 1-6. They contribute, and lay the foundation of the
temple, ver. 7-13.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="70.75%" prev="ii.xvi.iv.i" next="ii.xvi.v" id="ii.xvi.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p1">1. Seventh month - This was a sacred kind of month
wherein there were divers festivals, for which the people had been
preparing themselves, and now came to Jerusalem to the celebration of
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p2">2. Altar - Which was of more present necessity than the
temple, both to make atonement to God for all their sins, and to obtain
God's assistance for the building of the temple, and to strengthen their
own hearts and hands in that great work.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p3">3. For fear - So they made the more haste, lest they
should be hindered. Apprehension of dangers should quicken us in our
duty. Have we many enemies? We have the more need to have God for our
friend and to keep up our correspondence with him.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p4">4. Tabernacles - This seems to be mentioned for all the
solemnities of this month, whereof this was the most eminent, otherwise
it is not probable, that they would neglect the day of atonement which
was so severely enjoined, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxiii. 27-29" id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Lev|23|27|23|29" osisRef="Bible:Lev.23.27-Lev.23.29">Lev. xxiii, 27-29</scripRef>, and was so exceeding suitable to their present
condition.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p5">5. Offering - The morning and evening, sacrifice. The law
required much; but they offered more; for tho' thy had little wealth,
they had much zeal. Happy they that bring with them out of the furnace
of affliction, such a holy heat as this!</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p6">6. Burnt-offerings - And the other sacrifices which were
to be offered with them upon that day, being the feast of trumpets.
Burnt-offerings are often put for all sacrifices.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p7">9. Joshua - Not the high-priest so called, but a Levite,
of whom see chap. ii, 40. To set forward - To encourage them to a
vigourous prosecution of the work.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p8">11. Sung - That everlasting hymn, which will never be out
of date, and to which our tongue should never be out of tune, the burden
of <scripRef passage="Psalm 1" id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Ps|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.1">Psalm 1</scripRef>xxxvi, 1-26. Whatever our condition is, let it be owned, that
God is good, and whatever fails, that his mercy fails not.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p9">12. Had seen - Which divers of them might well do;
because it was destroyed not sixty years ago. Wept - Because of the poor
preparations made for this, in comparison of what was made for the other
temple: because this was destitute of those things which were the
principal glory of the former temple, namely, the ark, and the Urim and
Thummim; because these foundation-stones were far inferior to the
former, both for quantity and price, <scripRef passage="1 Kings vii. 9, 10" id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p9.1" parsed="|1Kgs|7|9|7|10" osisRef="Bible:1Kgs.7.9-1Kgs.7.10">1 Kings vii, 9, 10</scripRef>, and because these foundations were of a far narrower
compass than the former: for although the foundations of this house of
the Lord, strictly so called, were of equal largeness with those of the
former, yet the foundations of the whole building belonging to the first
temple, were far larger than these.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.iv.ii-p10">13. Could not discern - The mixture of sorrow and joy
here, is a representation of this world. In heaven all are singing and
none sighing; in hell all are wailing, and none rejoicing: but here on
earth we can scarce discern the shouts of joy from the noise of the
weeping, let us learn to rejoice with them that rejoice, and weep with
them that weep. Meantime let us ourselves rejoice as though we rejoiced
not, and weep as though we wept not.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="70.80%" prev="ii.xvi.iv.ii" next="ii.xvi.v.i" id="ii.xvi.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra IV" id="ii.xvi.v-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="70.80%" prev="ii.xvi.v" next="ii.xvi.v.ii" id="ii.xvi.v.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.v.i-p1">THE adversaries, not being allowed to build with them,
endeavour to hinder the work, ver. 1-5. They falsely accuse them to
Artaxerxes, ver. 6-16. Who thereupon orders the work to be stopt, ver.
17-22. It is stopt, ver. 23, 24.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="70.81%" prev="ii.xvi.v.i" next="ii.xvi.vi" id="ii.xvi.v.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p1">1. The adversaries - The Samaritans. The relicks of the
ten tribes, and the foreigners who had joined with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p2">2. With you - This they spake not sincerely, but that by
this conjunction with them, they might pry into their counsels, and
thereby find some matter of accusation against them. We seek - For so
they did, though in a mongrel way, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xvii. 26" id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p2.1" parsed="|2Kgs|17|26|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.17.26">2 Kings xvii, 26</scripRef>, &amp;c. Esarhaddon - Son of Sennacherib, and after him king
of Assyria, who brought or sent these persons hither, either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p3">1. in the day's of Salmanasar, who reigned
in Assyria but eight years before Esarhaddon; and so Esarhaddon might be
one of his commanders, and the man by whom that colony was sent. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p4">2. in the reign of Esarhaddon, who sent
this second colony to strengthen the first.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p5">3. With us - As being of another nation and religion, and
therefore not concerned in Cyrus's grant, which was confined to the
Israelites. Take heed, whom you go partners with, and on whose hand you
lean. While we trust God with an absolute confidence, we must trust men
with a prudent caution.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p6">5. Cyrus - For though Cyrus still favoured the Jews, yet
he was then diverted by his wars, and his son Cambyses was left his
vice- roy, who was a wicked prince, and an enemy to the Jews. Until -
Hebrew. and until, &amp;c. not only in the reign of Cyrus but also of
Cambyses, and of the magician, after whom was Darius.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p7">6. Ahasuerus - A common name to divers kings of Persia.
Cambyses the son and successor of Cyrus, was known to be no friend to
the Jewish nation.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p8">7. Artaxerxes - Cambyses, called by his Chaldee name,
Ahashuerus, ver.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p9">6, and here by his Persian name, Artaxerxes: by which he
is here called in the inscription of this letter, because so he was
called by himself, and others in the letters written either by him; or
to him. Interpreted - It was written in the Chaldee or Syrian language,
and in the Syrian character: for sometimes the Chaldee or Syrian words
are written in the Hebrew character.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p10">10. Asnapper - Either Esarhaddon, or some other person of
eminency, who was captain of this colony, and conducted them hither. The
river - Euphrates. Time - The date of the epistle was particularly
expressed therein, but here it was sufficient to note it in general.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p11">12. Be it known, &amp;c. - This is a mere fiction, which
being confidently affirmed, they thought would easily find belief with a
king whose heart and ears they possessed by their hired counsellors.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p12">23. To cease. &amp;c. - As they abused the king by their
misinformations, in the obtaining of this order, so they abused him in
the execution of it; for the order was only to prevent the walling of
the city. But having power in their hands, they, on this pretense, stopt
the building of the temple. See what need we have to pray, not only for
kings, but for all in authority under them: because the quietness of our
lives depends much on the integrity and wisdom of inferior magistrates
as well as the supreme.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.v.ii-p13">24. Darius - Darius the son of Hystaspes, successor of
Cambyses.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="70.86%" prev="ii.xvi.v.ii" next="ii.xvi.vi.i" id="ii.xvi.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra V" id="ii.xvi.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="70.86%" prev="ii.xvi.vi" next="ii.xvi.vi.ii" id="ii.xvi.vi.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.vi.i-p1">Zerubbabel encouraged by Haggai and Zechariah, sets the
work forward again, ver. 1, 2. Their adversaries oppose them again, ver.
3-5. Write to Darius, ver. 6-17.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="70.86%" prev="ii.xvi.vi.i" next="ii.xvi.vii" id="ii.xvi.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.vi.ii-p1">1. The son - His grand-child; for he was the son of
Baraciah. Prophesied - Commanding them from God to return to building
the temple, with a promise of his favour and assistance.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vi.ii-p2">2. Helping - Encouraging the people to work by their
presence, and assurance of success. It is supposed, the work had stopt
about fifteen years. The first chapter of Haggai is the best comment on
these two verses.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vi.ii-p3">3. Shethar-boznai - Not Rehum and Shimshai, &amp;c. who
were either dead, or removed from their office by Darius.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vi.ii-p4">4. We - Jews. Accordingly - According to what they asked.
That made this building - That were the undertakers and encouragers of
it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vi.ii-p5">8. Great God - And indeed, thus far the greater part of
the Samaritans agreed with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vi.ii-p6">17. Now therefore. &amp;c. - If the case had been so
fairly stated to Artaxerxes, he would hardly have hindered the work. The
people of God could not be persecuted, if they were not belied.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="70.88%" prev="ii.xvi.vi.ii" next="ii.xvi.vii.i" id="ii.xvi.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra VI" id="ii.xvi.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="70.88%" prev="ii.xvi.vii" next="ii.xvi.vii.ii" id="ii.xvi.vii.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.vii.i-p1">Darius's answer, ver. 1-7. His decree, ver. 8-12. The
temple is finished, ver. 13-15. The dedication of it, ver. 16-18. The
passover kept, ver. 19-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="70.88%" prev="ii.xvi.vii.i" next="ii.xvi.viii" id="ii.xvi.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.vii.ii-p1">1. A decree - To search the rolls in Babylon, where
search was first made; but not finding the edict there, they searched in
Achmetha, or Ecbatana, and found it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vii.ii-p2">2. Achmetha - The royal city of the Medes and
Persians.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vii.ii-p3">3. Cubits - Those proportions differ from those of
Solomon's temple, which was but thirty cubits high, only the porch was a
hundred and twenty cubits high, and but twenty cubits in breadth. Either
therefore Solomon's cubits were sacred cubits, which were larger than
the other, and these but common cubits. Or, the sixty cubits of height
are meant only for the porch. And the word rendered breadth, may be
rendered the extension or the length of it; it being improbable that the
king should give orders about the breadth, and none about the length of
it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vii.ii-p4">12. Destroy - Tho' this temple was at length most justly
destroyed by the righteous hand of God, yet perhaps the Romans, who were
the instruments of that destruction, felt the effects of this curse. For
that empire sensibly declined ever after, 'till it was wholly
destroyed.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vii.ii-p5">14. Through the prophesying - This is a seasonable
intimation that this great and unexpected success was not to be ascribed
to chance, or to the kindness or good humour of Darius, but unto God
only, who by his prophets had required and encouraged them to proceed in
the work, and by his mighty power disposed Darius's heart to such kind
and noble purposes.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vii.ii-p6">21. Children of Israel - Probably some out of each of the
twelve tribes.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.vii.ii-p7">22. Joyful - He had given them both cause to rejoice, and
hearts to rejoice. God is the fountain whence all the streams of true
joy flow. Of Assyria - Of the king of Persia, who was now king of
Assyria also, here so called emphatically, to note the great power and
goodness of God in turning the hearts of these great monarchs, whose
predecessors had been the chief persecutors and oppressors of God's
people.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="70.92%" prev="ii.xvi.vii.ii" next="ii.xvi.viii.i" id="ii.xvi.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra VII" id="ii.xvi.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="70.92%" prev="ii.xvi.viii" next="ii.xvi.viii.ii" id="ii.xvi.viii.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.i-p1">An account of Ezra and his expedition to Jerusalem, ver.
1-10. The commission which Artaxerxes gave him, ver. 11-26. His
thankfulness to God for it, ver. 27, 28.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="70.92%" prev="ii.xvi.viii.i" next="ii.xvi.ix" id="ii.xvi.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p1">1. Artaxerxes - The same of whom he speaks, chap. vi, 14.
The son - His grand-son. Here are divers persons omitted for brevity
sake, which may be supplied out of <scripRef passage="1 Chron. vi. 1" id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|1Chr|6|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.6.1">1 Chron. vi, 1</scripRef>-xi, 47. Ezra was not himself the high priest; but he was
nearly related to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p2">6. Went - With the king's consent and commission. Scribe
- A learned and expert doctor. The Jews say, he collected and collated
all the copies of the law, and published an accurate edition of it, with
all the books that were given by Divine inspiration, and so made up the
canon of the Old Testament. Moses in Egypt, and Ezra in Babylon, were
wonderfully fitted for eminent service to the church. According, &amp;c.
- By the favour of God so disposing the heart of the king.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p3">10. To teach - The order of things in this verse is very
observable; first he endeavours to understand God's law and word, and
that not for curiosity or ostentation, but in order to practice: next he
consciously practices what he did understand, which made his doctrine
much more effectual: and then he earnestly desires and labours to
instruct others, that they also might know and do it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p4">11. Words - The phrase seems emphatical, noting that he
explained both the words and the things: for the Jews in the land of
their captivity had in a great measure lost both the language, and the
knowledge of God's commands, and therefore Ezra and his companions
instructed them in both.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p5">14. According, &amp;c. - To make inquiry into all abuses
and deviations from your law, and to redress them. Which - Which is now
and always in thine hand, being the matter of thy daily study.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p6">16. Find - Procure, as that word is used, <scripRef passage="Gen. vi. 8" id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Gen|6|8|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.6.8">Gen. vi, 8</scripRef>; xxvi, 12 <scripRef passage="Psalm 8" id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Ps|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ps.8">Psalm 8</scripRef>iv, 3. Whatsoever thou canst get of my
subjects by way of free gift. The people - Of Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p7">25. The wisdom - Which God hath put into thy heart, and
which appears in the works of thy hand. All that professed the Jewish
religion, were to be under the jurisdiction of these Judges.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p8">26. Let judgment - What could David himself, as king,
have done more, for the honour of God, and the furtherance of
religion?</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p9">27. Blessed, &amp;c. - Ezra cannot proceed in his story,
without inserting this thankful acknowledgment of God's goodness to him
and the people.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.viii.ii-p10">28. As the hand, &amp;c. - If God gives us his hand, we
are bold and chearful: if he withdraws it, we are weak as water.
Whatever service we are enabled to do for God and our generation, God
must have all the glory of it.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="70.96%" prev="ii.xvi.viii.ii" next="ii.xvi.ix.i" id="ii.xvi.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra VIII" id="ii.xvi.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="70.96%" prev="ii.xvi.ix" next="ii.xvi.ix.ii" id="ii.xvi.ix.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.ix.i-p1">The company that went up with Ezra, ver. 1-15. He sends
for the Levites, ver. 16-20. Proclaims a fast, ver. 21-23. Delivers the
treasure he brought to the priests and Levites, ver. 24-30. Goes on to
Jerusalem, ver. 31, 32. The treasure delivered in there, ver. 33, 34.
The people offer, ver. 35. The king's commissions delivered to his
lieutenants, ver. 36.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="70.97%" prev="ii.xvi.ix.i" next="ii.xvi.x" id="ii.xvi.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.ix.ii-p1">3. Males - Though the males only be expressed yet
doubtless they carried the women along with them, as they did the little
ones.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ix.ii-p2">13. Whose names are, &amp;c. - It seems the rest came
before; so that now all the sons of that family returned.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ix.ii-p3">15. Of Levi - None who were simple Levites, and not the
priests. And therefore the Levites mentioned, chap. vii, 7, by
anticipation were not yet come to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ix.ii-p4">18. By the good hand - If where ministers have been
wanting, the vacancies are well supplied, let us ascribe it to the good
hand of God, qualifying them for the service, inclining them to it, and
opening a door for them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ix.ii-p5">21. A fast - For public mercies. Publick prayers must be
made, that all who are to share in the comfort, may share in the
requests for it. Afflict ourselves - For our sins; and so be qualified
for the pardon of them. When we are entering on any new condition of
life, our care should be to bring into it none of the guilt of the sins
of our former condition. When we are in any imminent danger, let us make
our peace with God, and then nothing can hurt us. Right way - A safe and
prosperous journey; such a way and course as might be best for us.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ix.ii-p6">23. Intreated - He gave us an assurance of his gracious
answer to our request.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.ix.ii-p7">35. Sin offering - For it is the atonement that secures
every mercy to us, which will not be truly comfortable, unless iniquity
be taken away, and our peace made with God. They offer twelve bullocks,
twelve he-goats, and ninety six rams, (eight times twelve) signifying
the union of the two kingdoms. They did not any longer go two tribes one
way, and ten tribes another; but all the twelve met by their
representatives at the same altar.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="71.00%" prev="ii.xvi.ix.ii" next="ii.xvi.x.i" id="ii.xvi.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra IX" id="ii.xvi.x-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="71.00%" prev="ii.xvi.x" next="ii.xvi.x.ii" id="ii.xvi.x.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.x.i-p1">Ezra is troubled at the marriages with strange women,
ver. 1-4. His solemn confession to God, ver. 5-15.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="71.00%" prev="ii.xvi.x.i" next="ii.xvi.xi" id="ii.xvi.x.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p1">3. I rent - Both mine inner and my upper garment.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p2">4. Evening sacrifice - When the people used to assemble
together. All good people ought to own those that appear and act for God
against vice and profaneness. Everyone that fears God, ought to stand
by them, and do what he can to strengthen their hands.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p3">5. Heaviness - From that mournful posture, and put myself
into the posture of a petitioner. He did this at the time of the evening
sacrifice, because then devout people used to come into the courts of
the temple, that hearing his confession, they likewise might be made
sensible of the sins of the people. And he had an eye to that great
propitiation, of which that sacrifice was a peculiar type.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p4">6. Our - He includes himself in the number of the
transgressors, because he himself was guilty of many sins; and because
the princes and priests, and so many of the people having done this, the
guilt was now become national.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p5">7. Have we been - We are not purged from the guilt of our
fathers sins, but we are still feeling the sad effects of them; yea, and
are repeating the same sins.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p6">8. A little space - It is but a little while since God
hath delivered us, and yet we are already returned to our sin. A remnant
- The far greatest part of the Israelitish nation were yet in captivity.
A nail - Some kind of settlement; whereas before we were tossed and
removed from place to place as our masters pleased. It is a metaphor
from tents, which are fastened by cords and nails, or pins. Holy place -
In Jerusalem, called the holy city, <scripRef passage="Neh. xi. 1, 18" id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Neh|11|1|0|0;|Neh|11|18|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.11.1 Bible:Neh.11.18">Neh. xi, 1, 18</scripRef> <scripRef passage="Dan. ix. 24" id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Dan|9|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.9.24">Dan. ix, 24</scripRef>, which is peculiarly mentioned, because of the temple, which
was the nail that fastened their tents and gave them some hopes of
continuing in their land. To lighten - That he might revive and comfort
our hearts. For as darkness is often put for a state of sorrow and
affliction, so light is put for joy and comfort. In bondage - For we are
not quite delivered, being even here in subjection to our former
lords.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p7">9. A wall - The favour of the kings of Persia whose
edicts were their security against all those enemies wherewith they were
encompassed: and the gracious providence of God, which had planted them
in their own land, and watched over them from time to time.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p8">11. It is unclean - This land is as corrupt as any of the
rest of the heathen nations.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p9">12. Strong - Although you may fancy making leagues and
marriages with them, as the only way to establish you, yet I assure you,
it will weaken and ruin you, and the contrary course will make you
strong.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.x.ii-p10">15. We are - We are here in thy presence, and so are all
our sins; we are arraigning ourselves before thy tribunal, acknowledging
thee to be just, if thou destroy us. Before thee - In judgment, as that
word is often used, we must needs fall and perish at thy presence.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="71.05%" prev="ii.xvi.x.ii" next="ii.xvi.xi.i" id="ii.xvi.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Ezra X" id="ii.xvi.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Ezra|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvi.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="71.05%" prev="ii.xvi.xi" next="ii.xvi.xi.ii" id="ii.xvi.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.i-p1">The people mourn, ver. 1. Shechaniah encourages Ezra to
put away the strange wives, ver. 2-4. All Israel swear to do it, ver. 5.
Ezra, mourning assembles the people, ver. 6-9 They all, on his
exhortation, agree to the reformation, ver. 10-14. They perform it, ver.
15-17. The names of them that had married strange wives, ver. 18-44.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="71.06%" prev="ii.xvi.xi.i" next="ii.xvii" id="ii.xvi.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p1">1. There assembled - The account of his grief, and
publick expressions thereof in the court before the temple, being in an
instant dispersed over all the city, brought a great company together.
See what an happy influence the example of great ones may have upon
their inferiors!</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p2">2. We - He saith, we, in the name of the people, and
their several families, and his own amongst the rest. For this man's
name is not in the following catalogue, but there we have his father,
Jehiel, and his father's brethren, five other sons of his grandfather,
Elam, ver. 26. It was therefore an evidence of his great courage, and
good conscience, that he durst so freely discharge his duty, whereby he
shewed, that he honoured God more than his nearest and dearest
relations. Hope - In case of our repentance, and reformation.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p3">3. Such as are born - These children were only cast out
of the common-wealth of Israel, but were not utterly forsaken; probably
care was taken by authority, that they should have provision made for
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p4">6. Went - That with the princes and elders, he might
consult about the execution of their resolution. Thither - 'Till he saw
something done.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p5">9. Of Judah - Not only of these two tribes, as appears
from the following catalogue, where there are priests and Levites; but
all the Israelites, ver. 25, who are thus described, because the
greatest part of them were of these tribes, though others were mixed
with them: and because they all now dwelt in that land, which formerly
was appropriated to those tribes. The street - In that street of the
city, which was next the temple, and within the view of it, that so they
might be as in God's presence, whereby they might be awed to a more
faithful and vigourous prosecution of their work. And this place they
might chuse rather than the court of the people, because they thought it
might be polluted by the delinquents, who were all to come thither.
Great rain - Which they took for a token of God's displeasure against
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p6">14. Our rulers - Let the great council, called the
Sanhedrim, be settled, and meet to determine of all particular causes.
Judges - Who are best able to inform the great council of the quality of
the persons, and all matters of fact and circumstances. Until - Until
the thing be done, and God's wrath thereby removed.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p7">15. Employed - To take care that the business should be
executed in the manner proposed, that the officers and delinquents of
every city should come successively in convenient time and order, as
these should appoint, to keep an exact account of the whole transaction,
and of the names of the cities and persons whose causes were dispatched,
to give notice to others to come in their turns, and to prepare the
business for the hearing of the Judges. These two were priests, as their
helpers were Levites; that so they might inform the persons concerned,
in any matter of doubt.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p8">16. Separated - Sequestered themselves from all other
business, and gave themselves wholly to this.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p9">25. Of Israel - Of the people of Israel, distinguished
from the priests and Levites hitherto named.</p>

<p id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p10">44. Had children - This implies that most of their wives
were barren. Which came to pass by God's special providence, to manifest
his displeasure against such matches, and that the putting them away
might not be encumbered with too many difficulties. One would think this
grievance altogether removed. Yet we meet with it again, <scripRef passage="Neh. xiii. 22" id="ii.xvi.xi.ii-p10.1" parsed="|Neh|13|22|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.13.22">Neh. xiii, 22</scripRef>. Such corruptions are easily and insensibly brought in, tho'
not easily purged out. The best reformers can but do their endeavour. It
is only the Redeemer himself, who when he cometh to Sion, will
effectually turn away ungodliness from Jacob.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE BOOK OF NEHEMIAH" progress="71.12%" prev="ii.xvi.xi.ii" next="ii.xvii.i" id="ii.xvii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh" id="ii.xvii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.xvii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE BOOK OF NEHEMIAH</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Nehemiah" progress="71.12%" prev="ii.xvii" next="ii.xvii.ii" id="ii.xvii.i">
<h3 id="ii.xvii.i-p0.1">NEHEMIAH.</h3> 

<p id="ii.xvii.i-p1">THIS book continues the history of the children of the
captivity, the Jews lately returned out of Babylon. We have a full
account of Nehemiah's labours for them, in these his commentaries:
wherein he records not only the works of his hands, but the very
workings of his heart, inserting many devout reflections and
ejaculations, which are peculiar to his writing. Twelve years he was the
tirshatha, or governor of Judea, under the same Artaxerxes that gave
Ezra his commission. This book relates his concern for Jerusalem and
commission to go thither, chap. 1, 2. His building the wall of
Jerusalem, notwithstanding much opposition, chap. 3, 4. His redressing
the grievances of the people, chap. 5. His finishing the wall, chap. 6.
The account he took of the people, chap. 7. His calling the people to
read the law, fast and pray, and renew their covenant, chap. 8-10. He
peoples Jerusalem and settles the tribe of Levi, chap. 11, 12. He
reforms divers abuses, chap. 13. This was the last historical book that
was written, as Malachi, the last prophetical book of the old
testament.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="71.14%" prev="ii.xvii.i" next="ii.xvii.ii.i" id="ii.xvii.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. I" id="ii.xvii.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="71.14%" prev="ii.xvii.ii" next="ii.xvii.ii.ii" id="ii.xvii.ii.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.ii.i-p1">Nehemiah is informed of the deplorable state of the Jews
at Jerusalem, ver. 1-3. He fasts and prays, ver. 4-11</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="71.14%" prev="ii.xvii.ii.i" next="ii.xvii.iii" id="ii.xvii.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.ii.ii-p1">1. The words - Or rather, the acts, as the word often
signifies. Chisleu - Which is the ninth month, containing part of
November, and part of December. Year - Of Artaxerxes. Shushan - The
royal city of Persia.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ii.ii-p2">3. The province - In Judea, now a province under the
Persian monarchs. The wall, &amp;c. - The walls and gates continue as
Nebuchadnezzar left them; the Jews not being in a condition to rebuild
them, nor having commission from the kings of Persia to do so.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ii.ii-p3">4. The God of heaven - Who seeth in secret; secret;
having no opportunity of doing it openly.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ii.ii-p4">6. Which I pray, &amp;c. - He refers to all the prayers,
which he had for some time been putting up.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ii.ii-p5">11. To fear thy name - Those who truly desire to fear his
name, shall be graciously accepted of God. This man - The king: who is
but a man and therefore his heart is wholly at thy disposal. favour with
men is then comfortable, when we see it springing from the mercy of God.
Cup-bearer - Whereby I had opportunity to speak to him, and some favour
with him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="71.16%" prev="ii.xvii.ii.ii" next="ii.xvii.iii.i" id="ii.xvii.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. II" id="ii.xvii.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="71.16%" prev="ii.xvii.iii" next="ii.xvii.iii.ii" id="ii.xvii.iii.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.i-p1">Artaxerxes sends Nehemiah to Jerusalem, with a commission
to build the wall, ver. 1-8. He comes thither, to the grief of his
enemies, ver. 9-11. He secretly views the ruins of it, ver. 12-16. He
informs the rulers of his commission, ver. 17, 18. Answers them that
derided him, ver. 19, 20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="71.17%" prev="ii.xvii.iii.i" next="ii.xvii.iv" id="ii.xvii.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p1">1. Nisan - Four months after he had heard those sad
tidings. The reason of this long delay might be either that his turn of
attending upon the king did not come 'till that time: or that 'till then
he wanted a fit opportunity to move it to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p2">2. Sad - His fasting joined with inward grief had made a
sensible change in his countenance. Afraid - It was an unusual and
ungrateful thing to come into the king of Persia's presence with any
token of sorrow. And he feared a disappointment, because his request was
great and invidious, and odious to most of the Persian courtiers.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p3">3. Why should, &amp;c. - All the grievances of the
church, but especially its desolations, ought to be matter of grief to
all good people, to all that have a concern for God's honour, and are of
a public spirit.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p4">4. Let, &amp;c. - My sadness comes not from any
disaffection to the king, for whom my hearty prayers are that he may
live forever; but from another cause. Sepulchres - Which by all nations
are esteemed sacred and inviolable. He saith not a word of the temple as
he spake before a Heathen king who cared for none of these things. I
prayed - To direct my thoughts and words, and to incline the king's
heart to grant my request.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p5">6. The queen - Which is here noted, as an unusual thing;
for commonly the kings of Persia dined alone, and perhaps because the
queen expressed some kindness to him, and promoted his request. How long
- This question shewed the king's affection to him, and that he was not
willing to want his attendance longer than was necessary. A time - He
built the walls in fifty two days, chap. vi, 15, and probably not long
after returned to the king, by whom he was sent a second time with a
more ample commission.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p6">8. King's forest - Of the forest of Lebanon, famous for
choice trees. Palace - Of the king's palace, which was adjoining to the
house of God. Enter - That I shall build to dwell in while I am
there.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p7">10. Horonite - So called either, from the place of his
birth or rule, which is supposed to be Horonaim, an eminent city of
Moab. The servant - So called probably from the condition from which he
was advanced to his present power and dignity: which also may be
mentioned as one reason why he now carried himself so insolently, it
being usual for persons suddenly raised from a low state, so to demean
themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p8">12. Night - Concealing both his intentions as long as he
could, knowing that the life of his business lay in secrecy and
expedition. Beast - To prevent noise.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p9">13. I went - The footmen who accompanied him directing
and leading him in the way. His design was to go round the city, to
observe the compass and condition of the walls and gates, that he might
make sufficient provisions for the work.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p10">14. No place - The way being obstructed with heaps of
rubbish.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p11">16. That did - Or, were to do, whom he intended to employ
in it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p12">18. Rise up - Let us do it with vigour, and diligence,
and resolution, as those that are determined to go through with it.
Their hands - Their own and one anothers.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iii.ii-p13">20. No portion - You have no authority over us, nor
interest in our church and state, but are aliens from the common-wealth
of Israel. Memorial - No testimony, or monument, either of your relation
to us by birth or religion, or of your kindness to us, or to this
place.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="71.23%" prev="ii.xvii.iii.ii" next="ii.xvii.iv.i" id="ii.xvii.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. III" id="ii.xvii.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="71.23%" prev="ii.xvii.iv" next="ii.xvii.iv.ii" id="ii.xvii.iv.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.i-p1">The names of those who presided over the builders, and
the parts which each company built, ver. 1-32.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="71.23%" prev="ii.xvii.iv.i" next="ii.xvii.v" id="ii.xvii.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p1">1. Eliashib - Grand-child of Joshua, the first
high-priest after their return from Babylon. Rose - Began the work.
Ministers should be foremost in every good work, animating others by
their example as well as doctrine. Sheep-gate - Which was next to the
temple; so called, because the sheep were brought thro' it to be
sacrificed. Sanctified - Or, they prepared or repaired it: for so the
word sometimes signifies. But our translation seems best, both because
that use of the word is most common, and because this is spoken only of
this gate, which being built by the priests, and nighest to the temple,
and with a special eye to the service of the temple, for which both men
and things were most commonly brought in this way, and being also the
first part of the building, might be in a peculiar manner sanctified by
solemn prayer and sacrifice, whereby it was dedicated to God's
service.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p2">5. Their nobles - Did not submit to it, would not further
it, either through sloth or covetousness, or secret compliance with the
enemies of the Jews. Of their Lord - Of God, whom they owned for their
Lord, whose work this was, because it had proceeded thus far by his
singular providence: and because it was done for the defense of the
city, and people, and temple of God. And therefore they are branded to
all posterity. Let not nobles think any thing beneath them, by which
they may benefit their country. What is their nobility good for, but
that it places them in an higher and larger sphere of usefulness?</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p3">7. The throne - Unto the place where the governor of the
country on this side Euphrates, under the Persian kings, sometimes had a
palace or throne.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p4">8. Fortified - It is not said, they repaired, but they
fortified it, either because this part of the wall was less demolished
than the other, and therefore they needed not to repair it, but only to
make it stronger: or, to note their extraordinary care and diligence,
that they would not only repair it, but make it stronger than ever.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p5">9. Half part - As Rome was anciently divided into several
quarters or regions, so was Jerusalem; and especially into two parts,
whereof one was in the tribe of Benjamin, and nearest the temple, the
other in the tribe of Judah, these accordingly had two several rulers,
this man and the other, ver. 12, but both under the chief governor of
the city.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p6">12. His daughters - Who were either heiresses or rich
widows, and caused part to be done at their charges.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p7">14. Beth-haccerem - A town or territory, the government
whereof was divided between two persons.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p8">16. Made - By Hezekiah, <scripRef passage="2 Kings xx. 20" id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p8.1" parsed="|2Kgs|20|20|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Kgs.20.20">2 Kings xx, 20</scripRef>. Whereby it is distinguished from that pool which was
natural. Mighty - Or, of the valiant: which possibly was formerly
appointed for the receipt of those chief captains that should attend
upon the king in their courses.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p9">20. Earnestly - Did his work with eminent diligence and
fervency: which is here noted to his commendation. And it is probable,
this good man's zeal provoked many, to take the more pains, and make the
more haste.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p10">21. The door - Therefore the door was not in the middle
of the house, as now they commonly are, but at one end of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p11">27. Tekoites - The same spoken of before, who having
dispatched their first share sooner than their brethren, freely offered
to supply the defects of others, who, as it seems, neglected that part
of the work which had been committed to them. And this their double
diligence is noted both for the greater shame of their nobles, who would
not do any part of it, and for their own honour, who were so far from
being corrupted by that bad example, that they were quickened to greater
zeal and industry in this pious work.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.iv.ii-p12">30. The sixth son of Zalaph - It seems, his five elder
brethren, laid not their hands to the work. But in doing that which is
good, we need not stay to see our betters go before us.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="71.30%" prev="ii.xvii.iv.ii" next="ii.xvii.v.i" id="ii.xvii.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. IV" id="ii.xvii.v-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="71.30%" prev="ii.xvii.v" next="ii.xvii.v.ii" id="ii.xvii.v.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.v.i-p1">The enemies scoff, but Nehemiah prays, and continues the
work, ver. 1-6. To frustrate their design, he prays and sets a guard,
ver. 7-13. He encourages the workmen, and directs them how to proceed,
ver. 14-18. His farther directions, ver. 19-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="71.30%" prev="ii.xvii.v.i" next="ii.xvii.vi" id="ii.xvii.v.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p1">2. In a day - Do they intend to begin, and finish the
work, all in one day? For if they spend any long time about it, they
cannot think that we will suffer them to do it. The stones - Will they
pick up their broken stones out of the ruins, and patch them together.
Burnt - Which stones were burnt, and broken, by the Chaldeans when they
took the city.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p2">4. A prey - Give them for a prey to their enemies, and
let these carry them into the land of captivity.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p3">5. Cover not - Let their wickedness be in thy sight, so
as to bring down judgments upon them, that either they may be reformed,
or others may be warned by their example. God is said to cover or hide
sin when he forbears to punish it. Provoked thee - They have not only
provoked us builders, but thee also.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p4">6. The half - Unto half its height.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p5">10. Judah - The Jews now dwelling in Judah, some of them
being partly terrified by their enemies, and partly wearied with
continual labour. Rubbish - More than we are able suddenly to remove.
Not able - Being forced to spend our time in removing the rubbish, and
therefore we must desist for a season.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p6">12. By them - Or, among them: whereby they came to the
knowledge of their counsels. Tho' these had not zeal enough to help in
the work, yet they had some concern for their brethren. Ten tribes -
Very often, a certain number for an uncertain. Be upon you - They will
invade you every way, by which we can come to you, or you to us;
therefore keep watches on every side.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p7">13. Behind - Within the walls where they were not yet
raised to their due height, and therefore most liable to the enemies
assault. Higher - Upon the tops of the walls where they were finished,
and the towers which were built here and there upon the wall; whence
they might shoot arrows, or throw stones.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p8">14. Looked - He looked up, engaged God for him, and put
himself and his cause under the Divine protection. That was his way, and
should be ours: all his cares, all his griefs, all his fears he spread
before God. Great and terrible - You think your enemies are great and
terrible. But what are they in comparison of God? Especially in
opposition to him?</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p9">16. From that time forth - Lest our enemies should repeat
their enterprize. My servants - Of my domestick servants, and of my
guards. Held, &amp;c. - All their weapons: they stood in their arms
prepared for battle. Were behind - To encourage them in their work,
sometimes to assist with their own hands: and to direct and command them
in case of an assault. Judah - The Jews who were upon the wall.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p10">17. A Weapon - This is to be taken figuratively; being a
proverbial speech, as when they say of a man pretending kindness, he
carries bread in one hand, and a stone in another. Thus must we work out
our salvation, with the weapons of our warfare in our hands. For in
every duty we must expect opposition from our spiritual enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p11">18. Sounded - To call the people together, when, and
where it was necessary.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.v.ii-p12">23. Washing - When they were to wash and cleanse
themselves from some impurity, which might befall them or their
garments.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="71.35%" prev="ii.xvii.v.ii" next="ii.xvii.vi.i" id="ii.xvii.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. V" id="ii.xvii.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="71.35%" prev="ii.xvii.vi" next="ii.xvii.vi.ii" id="ii.xvii.vi.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.i-p1">The poor complain of being oppressed by the rich, ver.
1-5. Nehemiah removes the oppression, ver. 6-13. He sets an example of
compassion on the poor, ver. 14-19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="71.36%" prev="ii.xvii.vi.i" next="ii.xvii.vii" id="ii.xvii.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p1">2. Many - Which is in itself a blessing, but to us is
turned into a curse. Take up - We are forced to take up corn, upon
unreasonable terms.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p2">3. The dearth - Which might happen, both from the
multitude of the people in and near Jerusalem, from their work, which
wholly took them up, and kept them from taking care of their families,
and from the expectation of their enemies invasion, which hindered them
from going abroad to fetch provision, and the people round about from
bringing it to them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p3">5. Our flesh - We are of the same nature, and religion
with them, though they treat us as if we were beasts or Heathens.
Bondage - We are compelled to sell them for our subsistence. Daughters -
Which was an evidence of their great necessity, because their daughters
were more tender, and weak, and unfit for bond-service, and more exposed
to injuries than their sons. Redeem - Which we are allowed to do, <scripRef passage="Exod. xxi. 7-11" id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Exod|21|7|21|11" osisRef="Bible:Exod.21.7-Exod.21.11">Exod. xxi, 7-11</scripRef>, but have not wherewith to do it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p4">7. Exact - Which was against the plain and positive law
of God, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxiii. 19, 20" id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Deut|23|19|23|20" osisRef="Bible:Deut.23.19-Deut.23.20">Deut. xxiii, 19, 20</scripRef>, especially in this time of publick calamity. I set - I
called a publick congregation, both of the rulers and people, the
greatest part whereof were free from this guilt, and therefore more
impartial Judges of the matter, and represented it to them, that the
offenders might be convinced, and reformed; if not for fear of God, or
love of their brethren, yet at least for the publick shame and the cries
of the poor. Ezra, and Nehemiah were both good and useful men; but of
how different tempers? Ezra was a man of a mild tender spirit, and when
told of the sin of the rulers, rent his clothes and wept: Nehemiah
forced them to reform, being of a warm and eager spirit. So God's work
may be done, and yet different methods taken in doing it; which is a
good reason why we should not arraign the management of others, nor make
our own standard.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p5">8. We - I, and my brethren, and predecessors, have used
our utmost interest and power, both with the kings of Persia, that our
brethren might be redeemed from bondage, and with particular persons in
Babylon, and Persia, whose bond-slaves the Jews were, and who would not
part with them without a price. Be sold - Do you expect that we should
pay you a price for them, as we did to the Babylonians?. Or, must we use
as much importunity to solicit you for their redemption, as we did to
their enemies?</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p6">9. Reproach - Who are round about you, and observe all
your actions, and will reproach both you for such barbarous usage of
your brethren, and religion for your sakes.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p7">10. Brethren - In office; these who are employed with me
in the government of this people. Servants - In my name, and for my use.
Exact - As a just recompense for our pains and care for the publick
good, to which we wholly devote ourselves, even to the neglect of all
our private concerns. But I freely remit my own right, and therefore you
also ought to do so, seeing I lay no burden upon you, but what I am
willing to bear a part of upon my own shoulders.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p8">11. Also - Also require not: which is to be supplied out
of the next verse, where it is expressed in their grant of this desire.
Hundredth part - Which they required every month for the use of their
monies or goods, according to the custom then used.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p9">12. Require - For the hundredth part. Priests - As
witnesses; that the oath being taken before the priests, who acted in
God's name, the oath might make the more deep and durable impression
upon their consciences.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p10">13. My lap - The extreme parts of my garment, which I
first folded together, and then shook it and scattered it asunder. This
was a form of swearing then in use.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p11">14. Twelve years - Not that he continued so long together
at Jerusalem, but he so long governed Jerusalem by himself when present,
and in his absence, by a deputy. The bread - That allowance which by the
laws of God and nations, and of the king of Persia, the governors might
require.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p12">15. The former - Not Ezra, who was no governor, nor
Zerubbabel, but others between him and Nehemiah, whom he forbears to
name. Beside, &amp;c. - Which they required of the people every day to
defray their other expenses. Their servants - Ruled them with rigor and
cruelty; which fault of the servants is charged upon their masters,
because they did not restrain them. He had an awe of God's mercy, and a
fear of offending him. Those that truly fear God, will not dare to do
any thing cruel or unjust. And this is not only a powerful, but an
acceptable principle both of justice and charity.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p13">16. I continued - Overseeing, directing, and encouraging
the workmen, which was my whole business; and this at my own cost.
Bought - Of our poor brethren, whose necessities gave abundant
opportunity of enriching myself with good bargains.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p14">17. Rulers - Not only Jews of the inferior sort, for whom
meaner provisions might suffice, but also their rulers, for whom better
provision was fit; who resorted to him upon all occasions, to give him
notice of the enemies designs; or to receive his orders.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p15">18. Required not - But bore it out of my own estate:
which was very considerable, his office in the Persian court being a
place of great profit.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vi.ii-p16">19. According - As I have done thy people good for thy
sake, so do me good for thine own sake; for thou art pleased, and hast
promised graciously to reward us according to our works, and to mete to
men the same measure which they meet to others.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="71.45%" prev="ii.xvii.vi.ii" next="ii.xvii.vii.i" id="ii.xvii.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. VI" id="ii.xvii.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="71.45%" prev="ii.xvii.vii" next="ii.xvii.vii.ii" id="ii.xvii.vii.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.i-p1">Nehemiah's answer to his enemies, courting him to an
interview, ver. 1-4. To their charge of rebellion, ver. 5-9. To
Shemaiah's false prophecy, ver. 10-14. Notwithstanding the treachery of
some of the nobles, the work is finished, ver. 15-19</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="71.46%" prev="ii.xvii.vii.i" next="ii.xvii.viii" id="ii.xvii.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p1">1. The doors - Not all of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p2">2. Meet - To consult about the common service of our
master the king of Persia, or to make a friendly accommodation.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p3">4. Four times, &amp;c. - We must never be overcome by the
greatest importunity, to do anything ill or imprudent: but when we are
attacked with the same temptation, still resist it with the same reason
and resolution.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p4">5. Open letter - As speaking of a thing commonly
known.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p5">7. A king - We have now a king of our nation. Counsel -
That we may impartially examine the matter, that thy innocency may be
cleared.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p6">9. Strengthen my hands - A good prayer, when we are
entering on any particular services or conflicts in our Christian
warfare.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p7">10. Shut up - In his chamber adjoining to the temple,
upon pretense of singular devotion, and communion with God, and withal
upon pretense of certain knowledge, by the Spirit of God concerning
their approaching danger, from which thy could be safe nowhere but in
the temple. For if Nehemiah had done this, the people would have left
their work, and every one have shifted for his own safety.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p8">11. As I - I the chief governor, upon whose presence, the
very life of the whole city and nation in a great measure depends: I who
have professed such resolution, and courage, and confidence in God. I,
who have had such eminent experience of God's assistance, of his calling
me to this employment, and carrying me through it when our danger was
greater than now it is. Shall I now dishonour God and religion, and
betray the people and city of God by my cowardice? Go in - Tho' his life
depended upon it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p9">13. And sin - By going into a place forbidden to me, and
that in such a manner, which would have been both sinful and shameful.
Reproach - As a coward, and conscious of my own guilt, that they might
make me contemptible and odious both to my own people, and to the king
of Persia.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p10">14. My God, &amp;c. - This prayer we are not to
imitate.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.vii.ii-p11">15. Elul - Answering part to our August, and part to
September.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="71.49%" prev="ii.xvii.vii.ii" next="ii.xvii.viii.i" id="ii.xvii.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. VII" id="ii.xvii.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="71.49%" prev="ii.xvii.viii" next="ii.xvii.viii.ii" id="ii.xvii.viii.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.viii.i-p1">Nehemiah appoints persons to keep the city, ver. 1-4.
Reviews the people, ver. 5-7.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="71.49%" prev="ii.xvii.viii.i" next="ii.xvii.ix" id="ii.xvii.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.viii.ii-p1">3. Hot - 'Till it be clear and broad day; when the people
will be ready in case of an assault. They - The watches appointed to
that end. Watches - Nehemiah was now about to return to the court, and
left the charge of the city to these in his absence.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.viii.ii-p2">5. God put it into mine heart - Whatever good motion is
in our minds, we must acknowledge it to come from God. What is done by
human prudence is to be ascribed to the direction of Divine
Providence.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.viii.ii-p3">7. Tirshatha - Nehemiah. So it is no wonder that the
number of the monies, and other things here contributed, differ from
that <scripRef passage="Ezra ii. 68, 69" id="ii.xvii.viii.ii-p3.1" parsed="|Ezra|2|68|2|69" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.2.68-Ezra.2.69">Ezra ii,
68, 69</scripRef>, because this is another collection.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="71.51%" prev="ii.xvii.viii.ii" next="ii.xvii.ix.i" id="ii.xvii.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. VIII" id="ii.xvii.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="71.51%" prev="ii.xvii.ix" next="ii.xvii.ix.ii" id="ii.xvii.ix.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.ix.i-p1">The solemn reading and expounding of the law, ver. 1-8.
The joy of the people, ver. 9-12. The keeping of the feast of
tabernacles, ver. 13-18.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="71.51%" prev="ii.xvii.ix.i" next="ii.xvii.x" id="ii.xvii.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.ix.ii-p1">2. First day - This was the feast of trumpets, which is
called a sabbath, and on which they were to have an holy convocation, <scripRef passage="Lev. xxiii. 24" id="ii.xvii.ix.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Lev|23|24|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Lev.23.24">Lev. xxiii, 24</scripRef>. And it was on this day, the altar was set up, after their
return from captivity; in remembrance of which they had probably kept it
ever since, with more than ordinary solemnity.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ix.ii-p2">7. Understand - As well the words, which being Hebrew,
now needed to be translated into the Chaldee or Syriack language, now,
the common language of that people, who together with their religion,
had also in a great part lost their language; as also the meaning of
them: they expounded the mind and will of God in what they read, and
applied it to the peoples present condition. Place - That is, In their
several places and stations into which the company seems to have been
distributed for conveniency of hearing; it not being likely that so vast
a congregation could distinctly hear one man's voice. Or, by their
stations, that is, by the several stations of the Levites, and persons
last named; who seem to have had several scaffolds, by comparing this
with chap. ix, 4, upon which thy stood, as Ezra did upon his pulpit,
ver. viii, 4.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ix.ii-p3">8. They - Ezra and his companions successively. Sense -
The meaning of the Hebrew words, which they expounded in the common
language. Thy gave - So they gave them both a translation of the Hebrew
words into the Chaldee, and an exposition of the things contained in
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ix.ii-p4">9. Wept - Out of a sense of their guilt and danger by
reason of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ix.ii-p5">10. Eat - Feast before the Lord. Send - For the relief of
your poor brethren. Holy - Being the feast of trumpets, and the
beginning of this joyful month, wherein so many days of thanksgiving
were to be observed. Strength - Rejoicing in God in serving him with
chearfulness, and thankfulness, which is your duty always, but now
especially, will give you that strength both of mind and body, which you
greatly need, both to perform all the duties required of you, and to
oppose all the designs of your enemies.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ix.ii-p6">13. Levites - Chusing rather to confess their ignorance
than vainly to pretend to more knowledge than they had: wherein they
shew both humility, and serious godliness, that they were more careful
to learn their duty than to preserve their reputation.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ix.ii-p7">15. Mount - The Mount of Olives, which was next
Jerusalem, and stored with olive-branches, and probably with the rest:
for these trees seem to have been planted hereabouts principally, for
the use of the city in this very feast, which, though, long neglected,
should have been celebrated every year. And this place seems to be here
designed as the most eminent place, being put for any place near to the
several cities of Judah, where these branches were to be procured.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.ix.ii-p8">17. Done so - So, as to the manner and circumstances.
They never kept this feast so joyfully, having not only the same causes
of rejoicing which they formerly had, but special causes to increase
their joy; they never kept it so solemnly and religiously: for whereas
at other times, only the first and last day of that feast were
celebrated with an holy convocation, now there was an holy convocation,
and the people assembled, and attended upon the reading of the law,
every day of this feast.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="71.56%" prev="ii.xvii.ix.ii" next="ii.xvii.x.i" id="ii.xvii.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. IX" id="ii.xvii.x-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="71.57%" prev="ii.xvii.x" next="ii.xvii.x.ii" id="ii.xvii.x.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.x.i-p1">The people keep a solemn fast, ver. 1-3. The Levites
bless God for his goodness to them and their fathers, ver. 4-8. In Egypt
and in their journey out of it, ver. 9-12. On Mount Sinai, ver. 13, 14.
And their journey toward Canaan, ver. 15-18. In the wilderness, ver.
19-21. In driving out the Canaanites, ver. 22-26. In hearing their
prayer when in trouble, ver. 27-31. They confess their sin, ver. 32-37.
And seal a covenant with God, ver. 38.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="71.57%" prev="ii.xvii.x.i" next="ii.xvii.xi" id="ii.xvii.x.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p1">1. Now - The next day, but one after the feast of
tabernacles, which begun on the fourteenth day, and ended on the twenty
second, for their consciences having been fully awakened and their
hearts filled with grief for their sins, which they were not allowed to
express in that time of publick joy; now they resume their former
thoughts, and recalling their sins to mind, set apart a day for solemn
fasting and humiliation.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p2">2. Separated - From all unnecessary society with the
Heathens, and particularly from those strange women whom some of them
had married. For though Ezra had done this formerly, yet, it seems,
there were some criminals, without his knowledge, or, these were some
new delinquents, that since that time had fallen into the same error,
and shewed the truth of their repentance by forsaking their beloved
sins, and dearest relations.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p3">3. Book of the law - As they did before, giving them the
sense of what they read. Fourth part - For three hours; there were
twelve hours in their day, probably they began after the morning
sacrifice, and continued their work till the evening sacrifice. The work
of a fast-day is good work. We should endeavour to make a day's work, a
good day's work of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p4">4. Stairs - Upon such stairs, or pulpits, as the Levites
used to stand upon, when they taught the people. But they stood upon
several pulpits, each of them teaching that part of the congregation
which was allotted him, or praying, or blessing God with them. Loud
voice - Thereby testifying their deep sense of their sins and miseries,
and their servant, and importunate desire of God's mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p5">13. Good statutes - The moral and judicial precepts were
all founded on natural equity. And even the ceremonial were tokens of
God's goodness, being types of gospel-grace.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p6">17. Made - Designed, and resolved to do so, <scripRef passage="Num. xiv. 4" id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p6.1" parsed="|Num|14|4|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Num.14.4">Num. xiv, 4</scripRef>, and therefore they are said to do so, as Abraham is said to
have offered up Isaac, <scripRef passage="Heb. xi. 17" id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p6.2" parsed="|Heb|11|17|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Heb.11.17">Heb. xi, 17</scripRef>, because he intended to do it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p7">22. Divide - The Heathen nations, whom God in a great
measure destroyed, and the remainders of them he dispersed into corners;
that whereas before the Israelites came, they had large habitations, now
they were cooped up, some in one town, and some in another, in the
several corners of their land, while the Israelites dwelt in a large
place, and had the possession of their whole land, some few and small
parcels excepted.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p8">32. Mercy - He adds mercy, because the covenant in itself
was not a sufficient ground of hope, because they had so basely broken
it. God was discharged from keeping it, and therefore they fly to God's
free and rich mercy for relief.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p9">33. Thou art just. &amp;c. - It becomes us, when we are
under the rebukes of providence, be they ever so sharp, or ever so long
continued, still to justify God, and to own we are punished less than
our iniquities deserve.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p10">37. Yieldeth much, &amp;c. - We plow, and sow, and
labour, and thou givest thy blessing to our endeavours; and yet in a
great measure this is not for ourselves, as formerly it was, but for our
kings, to whom we pay heavy tributes. Dominion - Pressing or forcing
both us and our beasts to go and to do what they please.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.x.ii-p11">38. Sure covenant, &amp;c. - It was sealed and left upon
record, that it might be a witness against them, if they dealt
deceitfully.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="71.63%" prev="ii.xvii.x.ii" next="ii.xvii.xi.i" id="ii.xvii.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. X" id="ii.xvii.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="71.63%" prev="ii.xvii.xi" next="ii.xvii.xi.ii" id="ii.xvii.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.xi.i-p1">The names of those who set their seal to the covenant,
ver. 1- 27. An account of those who consented thereto, ver. 28-31. They
engage to adhere to the temple service, ver. 32-39.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="71.63%" prev="ii.xvii.xi.i" next="ii.xvii.xii" id="ii.xvii.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.xi.ii-p1">1. Sealed - Both in their own names, and in the name of
all the rest. It may seem strange that Ezra doth not appear among them.
But that might be because he was prevented, by some sickness, or other
extraordinary impediment. It is true, we meet with Ezra after this, at
the dedication of the wall of Jerusalem, chap. xii, 36, and therefore he
was then freed from this impediment, whatsoever it was.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xi.ii-p2">29. Their nobles - The commonality agreed with the nobles
in this good work, great men never look so great, as when they encourage
religion and are examples of it: and they would by that, as much as any
thing, make an interest in the most valuable of their inferiors, who
would cleave to them closer than they can imagine. Observe their nobles
are called their brethren; for in the things of God, rich and poor, high
and low meet together. They cleave - They ratified what the others had
done in their names, declaring their assent to it.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xi.ii-p3">31. People of the land - The Heathens. On the sabbath -
They that covenant to keep all the commandments of God, must
particularly covenant to keep the sabbath holy. For the profanation of
this is a sure inlet to all manner of profaneness.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="71.66%" prev="ii.xvii.xi.ii" next="ii.xvii.xii.i" id="ii.xvii.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. XI" id="ii.xvii.xii-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="71.66%" prev="ii.xvii.xii" next="ii.xvii.xii.ii" id="ii.xvii.xii.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.i-p1">The rulers and men drawn by lot dwell at Jerusalem, ver.
1, 2. Their names, numbers and families, ver. 3-19. The cities and
villages that were peopled by the rest, ver. 20-36.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="71.66%" prev="ii.xvii.xii.i" next="ii.xvii.xiii" id="ii.xvii.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.ii-p1">1. To dwell - That the buildings of the city might be
compleated, and the safety of it better provided for.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.ii-p2">2. Blessed - Because they denied themselves, and their
own safety and profit for the publick good; for this city was the butt
of all the malicious plots of their enemies; and for the present it was
rather chargeable than beneficial to its inhabitants.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.ii-p3">3. Province - Of Judea, which was now made a province.
Israel - The generality of the people of Israel, whether of Judah, or
Benjamin, or any other tribe. These he calls Israel rather than Judah,
because there were many of the other tribes now incorporated with them;
and because none of the tribes of Israel, except Judah and Benjamin,
dwelt in Jerusalem.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.ii-p4">9. Overseer - The captain of their thousand.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.ii-p5">16. Outward - For those things belonging to the temple
and its service, which were to be done without it, or abroad in the
country, as the gathering in of the voluntary contributions, or other
necessary provision out of the several parts of the land.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.ii-p6">17. To begin - In the publick and solemn prayers and
praises, which were constantly joined with the morning and evening
sacrifice, at which the singers were present, and praised God with a
psalm or hymn which, this man began.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.ii-p7">21. The Nethinims dwelt in Ophel - Which was upon the
wall of Jerusalem, because they were to do the servile work of the
temple: therefore they were to be posted near it, that they might be
ready to attend.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.ii-p8">24. Was, &amp;c. - Or, on the king's part, to determine
civil causes and controversies between man and man, by the laws of that
kingdom; between the king and people; as in matters of tribute, or
grievances.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xii.ii-p9">36. Divisions - Or, for the Levites (those who were not
settled in Jerusalem) there were divisions, places appointed for them,
and distributed among them. Thus were they settled free and easy, tho'
few and poor. And they might have been happy, but for that general
lukewarmness, with which they are charged by the prophet Malachi, who
prophesied about this time and in whom prophecy ceased for some ages,
'till it revived in the great prophet.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="71.70%" prev="ii.xvii.xii.ii" next="ii.xvii.xiii.i" id="ii.xvii.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. XII" id="ii.xvii.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="71.70%" prev="ii.xvii.xiii" next="ii.xvii.xiii.ii" id="ii.xvii.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.i-p1">The chief of the priests and Levites that came up with
Zerubbabel, ver. 1-9. The succession of the chief-priests, ver. 10- 21.
The eminent Levites, ver. 22-26. The wall dedicated, ver. 27- 43. The
offices of the priests and Levites settled, ver. 44-47.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="71.70%" prev="ii.xvii.xiii.i" next="ii.xvii.xiv" id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p1">1. Priests - The chief of the priests, the heads of those
twenty four courses which David appointed by divine direction, <scripRef passage="1 Chron. xxiv. 1-19" id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|1Chr|24|1|24|19" osisRef="Bible:1Chr.24.1-1Chr.24.19">1 Chron.
xxiv, 1-19</scripRef>. And whereas there were twenty four, and here but
twenty-two, and ver.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p2">12, &amp;c. only twenty, the reason of this difference
may be, because two of the twenty four courses were extinct in Babylon,
and two of the persons here named, ver. 2, 5, Hattush, and Maadiah, may
be omitted in the account of the posterity of these, ver. 12, &amp;c.
because they had no posterity. Ezra - Either this was another Ezra, or
if it were the same mentioned <scripRef passage="Ezra vii. 1" id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p2.1" parsed="|Ezra|7|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezra.7.1">Ezra vii, 1</scripRef>, he lived to a great age; which may well be supposed,
considering his great sobriety, and his great piety to which God
promised long life, and withal the special providence of God continuing
him so long in such a season, wherein the church of God did greatly need
his help and counsel.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p3">8. Moreover, &amp;c. - He was to see, that the Psalms of
thanksgiving were continually sung in the temple, in due time and
manner.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p4">10. Jeshua - Here follows a catalogue of the Jewish
high-priests; which was the more necessary, because their times were now
to be measured, not by the years of their kings as formerly, but by
their high-priests.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p5">12. Priests - As their fathers were priests in the days
of Joshua, so in the days of Joiakim the son of Joshua, the sons of
those persons executed the priesthood in their father's steads, some of
their fathers probably being yet living, and many of them dead.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p6">22. Darius - Darius Noehus; and so this Jaddua might be
father to him who was in the days of Darius Codomanus, and of Alexander
the Great.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p7">27. The wall - Of the city itself, which is here
dedicated to God, and to his honour and service, not only upon a general
account, by which we ought to devote ourselves, and all that is ours, to
God; but upon a more special ground, because this was a place which God
himself had chosen, and sanctified by his temple and gracious presence,
and therefore did of right belong to him; whence it is often called the
holy city. And they restored it to God by this dedication, withal
imploring the presence, and favour, and blessing of to this city by
solemn prayers, and praises, and sacrifices, wherewith this dedication
was accompanied. Places - To which they were now retired after that
great and general assembly, chap. 8, 9, &amp; 10. chap. viii, 1
&amp;c.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p8">30. Purified themselves - They that would be instrumental
to sanctify others, must sanctify themselves, and set themselves apart
for God, with purity of mind and sincerity of intention.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p9">31. Princes - And half of the people with them. The wall
- For the wall was broad and strong, and so ordered that men might
conveniently walk upon it. Right hand - Towards the south and east.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p10">39. Stood still - Waiting, as also their brethren did,
that they might go together in due order into God's house, there to
perfect the solemnity.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p11">43. The children rejoiced - And their hosanna's were not
despised, but are recorded to their praise. All that share in public
mercies, ought to join in public thanksgivings.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p12">44. Rejoiced - For the eminent gifts and graces which
they observed in many of them: for the great benefit which they had now
received by their ministry: and for the competent provision which hereby
was made for them, that so they might wholly wait upon their office. The
sure way for ministers to gain an interest, in the affections of their
people, is to wait on their ministry, to spend their whole time, and
thought, and strength therein.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p13">45. The ward - That ward, or charge, which God had
prescribed to them. And in particular the charge of purification, of
taking care that no unclean person or thing should enter into the house
or courts of the Lord.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiii.ii-p14">47. Sanctified - They set apart the first-fruits and
tithes from their own share, and devoted them to the use of the Levites.
And so did the Levites by the tithe of the tithes. Thus they all
conscientiously paid their dues, and did not profane those things which
God had sanctified, nor take them into their own common use. When what
is contributed for the support of religion, is given with an eye to God,
it is sanctified, and will cause the blessing to rest upon the house,
and all that is therein.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="71.78%" prev="ii.xvii.xiii.ii" next="ii.xvii.xiv.i" id="ii.xvii.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Neh. XIII" id="ii.xvii.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|Neh|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Neh.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xvii.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="71.78%" prev="ii.xvii.xiv" next="ii.xvii.xiv.ii" id="ii.xvii.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.i-p1">The Israelites are separated from the mixt multitude,
ver. 1-3. Nehemiah cleansed the chambers of the temple, ver. 4-9. He
recovers and secures the portion of the priests and Levites, ver. 10-14.
Contends with the nobles concerning the sabbath, and takes care for the
due observance of it, ver. 15-22. Restrains them from marrying strange
wives, ver. 23-31.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="71.78%" prev="ii.xvii.xiv.i" next="ii.xviii" id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p1">1. That day - Not presently after the dedication of the
wall and city, but upon a certain day, when Nehemiah was returned from
the Persian court to Jerusalem, from which he had been absent for some
considerable time, in which some errors and abuses had crept in. Not
come - Not be incorporated into the common-wealth of Israel, nor be
joined with any Israelite in marriage.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p2">3. Multitude - All the heathenish people with whom they
had contracted alliance.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p3">4. Eliashib - The high-priest. Chamber - Of the chambers,
the high-priest having the chief power over the house of God, and all
the chambers belonging to it. Tobiah - The Ammonite, and a violent enemy
to God's people.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p4">5. Prepared - By removing the things out of it, uniting
divers small chambers into one, and furnishing it for the use of Tobiah
when he came to Jerusalem: whom he seems to have lodged there, that he
might have more free communication with him.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p5">6. But, &amp;c. - Eliashib took the occasion of my
absence to do these things. Came I - From Jerusalem; where he had been
once and again.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p6">8. Grieved me - That so sacred a place should be polluted
by one who in many respects ought not to come there, being no priest, a
stranger, an Ammonite, and one of the worst of that people; and that all
this should be done by the permission and order of the high-priest.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p7">10. Not given - Which might be either,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p8">1. from this corrupt high-priest Eliashib,
who took their portions, as he did the sacred chambers, to his own use,
or employed them for the entertainment of Tobiah, and his other great
allies. Or,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p9">2. from the people, who either out of
covetousness reserved them to themselves, contrary to their own solemn
agreement, or were so offended at Eliashib's horrid abuse of sacred
things, that they abhorred the offering and service of God, and
therefore neglected to bring in their tithes, which they knew would be
perverted to bad uses. Fled - To his possession in the country, being
forced to do so for a livelihood.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p10">11. Contended - I sharply reproved those priests to whom
the management of those things was committed, for neglect of their duty,
and breach of their late solemn promise. Why, &amp;c. - You have not
only injured men in with-holding their dues, but you have occasioned the
neglect of God's house and service. Gathered - To Jerusalem from their
several country possessions. Set - Restored them to the exercise of
their office.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p11">12. Bought - Out of the respect which they had to
Nehemiah, and because they saw they would now be applied to their proper
uses.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p12">13. Faithful - By the consent of those who knew them.
Such he now sought out the more diligently, because he had experience of
the perfidiousness of the former trustees.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p13">16. Jerusalem - The holy city, where God's house was; and
where the great judicatories of the nation were. So this is added as an
aggravation of their sin, that it was done with manifest contempt of God
and man.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p14">17. Nobles - Their chief men and rulers; whom he charges
with this sin, because though others did it, it was by their countenance
or connivance: probably too by their example. If the nobles allowed
themselves in recreations, in idle visits and idle talk on the sabbath
day, the men of business would profane it by their worldly employments,
as the more justifiable of the two.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p15">19. At the gates - Out of a diffidence in those, to whom
the keeping of the gates was committed.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p16">22. Cleanse - Because the work they now were set upon,
though common in its nature, yet was holy in design of it, and had
respect unto the sabbath: and, because the day in which they were to do
this was the sabbath-day, for the observation whereof they were obliged
to purify themselves. Gates - The gates of the city; not daring to trust
the common porters, he commits the charge of them upon the sabbath-days,
to the Levites, to whom the care of sanctifying the sabbath did properly
belong. Mercy - Whereby he intimates, that though he mentioned his
good-works, as things wherewith God was well-pleased, and which he had
promised to reward, yet he neither did, nor durst trust to their merit,
or his own worthiness, but, when he had done all, he judged himself an
unprofitable servant, and one that needed God's infinite mercy to pardon
all his sins, and particularly those infirmities and corruptions which
adhered to his good deeds.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p17">25. Cursed - Caused them to be excommunicated and cast
out of the society of God's people. This and the following punishments
were justly inflicted upon them, because this transgression was contrary
both to a plain law of God, and to their own late solemn covenants.
Smote - I caused to be beaten with stripes, according to the law, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxv. 2" id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p17.1" parsed="|Deut|25|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.25.2">Deut. xxv, 2</scripRef>, such whose faults were most aggravated; to whom he added
this punishment over and above the former. Plucked off - Or, shaved
them. The hair was an ensign of liberty among the eastern nations; and
baldness was a disgrace, and token of slavery and sorrow.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p18">28. And one, &amp;c. - Said by Josephus to be that
Manasses, who by Sanballat's interest procured liberty to build the
Samaritan temple in mount Gerizim; to which those priests who had
married strange wives, or been otherwise criminal, betook themselves,
and with, or after them, others of the people in the same or like
circumstances. Chased - From my presence and court, from the city and
temple, and from the congregation and church of Israel.</p>

<p id="ii.xvii.xiv.ii-p19">31. For good - This may well be the summary of our
petitions. We need no more to make us happy but this.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE BOOK OF ESTHER" progress="71.88%" prev="ii.xvii.xiv.ii" next="ii.xviii.i" id="ii.xviii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esth" id="ii.xviii-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.xviii-p0.2">NOTES ON THE BOOK OF ESTHER</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Esther" progress="71.88%" prev="ii.xviii" next="ii.xviii.ii" id="ii.xviii.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.i-p1">BOTH Jews and Christians have generally supposed Mordecai
to be the writer of this book, which shews the care of God even over
those Israelites, who were still scattered among the Heathens. It is the
narrative of a plot to cut off all the Jews, disappointed by a wonderful
concurrence of providences. The name of God is not found in this book:
but the, finger of God is, directing so many minute events for the
deliverance of his people. The particulars are very encouraging to God's
people, in the most difficult and dangerous times. Here we are told how
Esther came to be queen, and Mordecai to be great at court, chap. 1, 2.
How Haman obtained an order for the destruction of the Jews, chap. 3.
The distress of the Jews thereupon, chap. 4. The defeating of Haman's
plot against Mordecai, chap. 5-7. The defeating of his plot against the
Jews, chap. 8. The care taken to perpetuate the memory of this, chap. 9,
10.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="71.90%" prev="ii.xviii.i" next="ii.xviii.ii.i" id="ii.xviii.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther I" id="ii.xviii.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="71.90%" prev="ii.xviii.ii" next="ii.xviii.ii.ii" id="ii.xviii.ii.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.i-p1">Ahasuerus feasts his great men, ver. 1-9. Sends for his
queen, who refuses to come, ver. 10, 11. He divorces her, ver.
12-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="71.90%" prev="ii.xviii.ii.i" next="ii.xviii.iii" id="ii.xviii.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p1">1. Ahasuerus - Many suppose this to be Darius Hystapas,
for his kingdom was thus vast, and he subdued India, as Herodotus
reports: and one of his wives was called Atossa, differing little from
Hadassah, which is Esther's other name, <scripRef passage="Esth ii. 7" id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p1.1" parsed="|Esth|2|7|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.2.7">Esth ii, 7</scripRef>. Provinces - So seven new provinces were added to those
hundred and twenty mentioned, <scripRef passage="Dan. vi. 1" id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p1.2" parsed="|Dan|6|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.6.1">Dan. vi, 1</scripRef>.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p2">2. Sat - Was settled in the peaceable possession of it.
Shushan - The chief or royal city. Shushan might be the proper name of
the palace, which thence was given to the whole city. Here the kings of
Persia used to keep their courts in winter, as at Exbatana in
summer.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p3">4. Many days - Making every day a magnificent feast,
either for all his princes, or for some of them, who might come to the
feast successively, as the king ordered them to do. The Persian feasts
are much celebrated in authors, for their length and luxury.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p4">6. Beds - For in those eastern countries, they did not
then sit at tables as we do, but rested or leaned upon beds or
couches.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p5">8. The law - According to this law which the king had now
made, that none should compel another to drink more than he pleased. How
does this Heathen prince shame many, that are called Christians, who
think they do not make their friends welcome, unless they make them
drunk, and under pretense of sending the health round, send the sin
round, and death with it!</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p6">9. Women - While the king entertained the men. For this
was the common custom of the Persians, that men and women did not feast
together.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p7">12. Refused - Being favoured in this refusal by the law
of Persia, which was to keep mens wives, and especially queens, from the
view of other men.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p8">13. The times - The histories of former times, what
princes have done in such cases as this was.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p9">14. Saw - Who had constant freedom of access to the king,
and familiar converse with him: which is thus expressed, because the
Persian kings were very seldom seen by their subjects. Sat - Who were
his chief counsellors and officers.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ii.ii-p10">18. Contempt - Contempt in the wives, and thereupon wrath
in the husbands; and consequently strife in families.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="71.93%" prev="ii.xviii.ii.ii" next="ii.xviii.iii.i" id="ii.xviii.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther II" id="ii.xviii.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="71.94%" prev="ii.xviii.iii" next="ii.xviii.iii.ii" id="ii.xviii.iii.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.iii.i-p1">The virgins of the kingdom are gathered together, ver.
1-4. And Esther with the rest, ver. 5-8. She finds favour with the
king's chamberlain, ver. 9-11. The manner of preparing the virgins, and
bringing them to the king, ver. 12-14. Esther pleases him, who makes her
queen, ver. 15-20. Mordecai discovers a conspiracy against the king,
ver. 21-23.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="71.94%" prev="ii.xviii.iii.i" next="ii.xviii.iv" id="ii.xviii.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.iii.ii-p1">3. Keeper - Of all the women, both virgins and
concubines: only the virgins he himself took care of, as requiring more
care and caution, and the concubines be committed to Shaashgaz, ver. 14,
his deputy. Purification - That is, to cleanse them from all impurities,
to perfume, and adorn, and every way prepare them for the king: for the
legal purification of the Jews he never regarded.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iii.ii-p2">7. Esther - Hadassah was her Hebrew name before her
marriage; and she was called Esther by the king after it.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iii.ii-p3">9. Pleased - Because she was very beautiful, therefore he
supposed she would be acceptable to the king; and by the Divine power,
which moveth the hearts of men which way he pleaseth.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iii.ii-p4">10. Shew it - Lest the knowledge hereof should either
make her contemptible, or bring some inconvenience to the whole nation;
but there was also an hand of God in causing this to be concealed, for
the better accomplishment of that which he designed, though Mordecai was
ignorant of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iii.ii-p5">13. Desired - For ornament, or by way of attendance. And
it should be observed, that every one whom the king took to his bed, was
his wife of a lower rank, as Hagar was Abraham's, so that it would have
been no sin or dishonour to Esther, though she had not been made
queen.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iii.ii-p6">19. Sat - By office, as one of the king's guards or
ministers; being advanced to this place by Esther's favour.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="71.97%" prev="ii.xviii.iii.ii" next="ii.xviii.iv.i" id="ii.xviii.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther III" id="ii.xviii.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="71.97%" prev="ii.xviii.iv" next="ii.xviii.iv.ii" id="ii.xviii.iv.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.iv.i-p1">Haman offended at Mordecai, resolves to destroy all the
Jews, ver. 1-6. He obtains an order from the king, to have them all
slain on one day, ver. 7-11. This order is sent throughout the kingdom,
ver. 12-15.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="71.97%" prev="ii.xviii.iv.i" next="ii.xviii.v" id="ii.xviii.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.iv.ii-p1">1. Agagite - An Amalekite of the royal seed of that
nation, whose kings were successively called Agag. All the princes -
Gave him the first place and seat, which was next to the king.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iv.ii-p2">2. But, &amp;c. - Probably the worship required was not
only civil, but Divine: which as the kings of Persia arrogated to
themselves, so they did sometimes impart this honour to some of their
chief favourites, that they should be adored in like manner. And that it
was so here, seems more than probable, because it was superfluous, to
give an express command to all the kings servants, to pay a civil
respect to so great a prince, which of course they used, and therefore a
Divine honour must be here intended. And that a Jew should deny this
honour, is not strange, seeing the wise Grecians did positively refuse
to give this honour to the kings of Persia themselves, even when they
were to make their addresses to them: and one Timocrates was put to
death by the Athenians for worshipping Darius in that manner.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iv.ii-p3">4. To see - What the event of it would be. For, &amp;c. -
And therefore did not deny this reverence out of pride, but merely out
of conscience.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iv.ii-p4">6. Scorn - He thought that vengeance was unsuitable to
his quality. Destroy - Which he attempted, from that implacable hatred
which, as an Amalekite, he had against them; from his rage against
Mordecai; and from Mordecai's reason of this contempt, because he was a
Jew, which as he truly judged, extended itself to all the Jews, and
would equally engage them all in the same neglect. And doubtless Haman
included those who were returned to their own land: for that was now a
province of his kingdom.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iv.ii-p5">7. They cast - The diviners cast lots, according to the
custom of those people, what day, and what month would be most lucky,
not for his success with the king (of which he made no doubt) but for
the most effectual extirpation of the Jews. Wherein appears likewise
both his implacable malice, and unwearied diligence in seeking vengeance
of them with so much trouble to himself; and God's singular providence
in disposing the lot to that time, that the Jews might have space to get
the decree reversed.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iv.ii-p6">11. The silver - Keep it to thy own use; I accept the
offer for the deed.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.iv.ii-p7">15. The city - Not only the Jews, but a great number of
the citizens, either because they were related to them, or engaged with
them in worldly concerns; or out of humanity and compassion toward so
vast a number of innocent people, appointed as sheep for the
slaughter.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="72.01%" prev="ii.xviii.iv.ii" next="ii.xviii.v.i" id="ii.xviii.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther IV" id="ii.xviii.v-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="72.01%" prev="ii.xviii.v" next="ii.xviii.v.ii" id="ii.xviii.v.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.v.i-p1">The Jews fast and mourn, ver. 1-3. Esther is informed of
the design, ver. 4-9, Mordecai presses her to intercede with the king,
ver. 10-14. She desires all the Jews to keep a solemn fast, ver. 15-
19.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="72.02%" prev="ii.xviii.v.i" next="ii.xviii.vi" id="ii.xviii.v.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.v.ii-p1">1. Cry - To express his deep sense of the mischief coming
upon his people. It was bravely done, thus publickly to espouse a just
cause though it seemed to be a desperate one.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.v.ii-p2">2. Sackcloth - Lest it should give the king any occasion
of grief and trouble. But what availed, to keep out the badges of sorrow
unless they could have kept out the causes of sorrow too? To forbid
sackcloth to enter unless they could likewise forbid sickness, and
trouble, and death?</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.v.ii-p3">4. To clothe - That so he might be capable of returning
to his former place, if not of coming to her to acquaint her with the
cause of his sorrow.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.v.ii-p4">11. Inner court - Within which, the king's residence and
throne was. Not called - This was decreed, to maintain both the majesty,
and the safety of the king's person; and by the contrivance of the
greater officers of state, that few or none might have access to the
king but themselves and their friends. I have not been called, &amp;c. -
Which gives me just cause to fear that the king's affections are
alienated from me, and that neither my person nor petition will be
acceptable to him.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.v.ii-p5">14. From another place - This was the language of strong
faith, against hope believing in hope. Who knoweth - It is probable God
hath raised thee to this honour for this very season. We should every
one of us consider, for what end God has put us in the place where we
are? And when an opportunity offers of serving God and our generation,
we must take care not to let it slip.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.v.ii-p6">16. Fast - And pray; so as you use to do, leave off your
common dinners by day, and suppers at night, and eat and drink no more
than mere necessity requires; that so you may give yourselves to
constant and fervent prayers. Maidens - Which she had chosen to attend
upon her person, and were doubtless either of the Jewish nation, or
Proselytes. Which is not, &amp;c. - Which may belong, either</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xviii.v.ii-p7">1. to the thing only, that as they did
fast, so she would. Or, rather,</p>

<p class="List3" id="ii.xviii.v.ii-p8">2. to the time of three days and three
nights; for so she might do, though she went to the king on the third
day. For the fast began at evening, and so she might continue her fast
three whole nights, and two whole days, and the greatest part of the
third; a part of a day being reputed a day in the account of scripture,
and other authors: of which see on <scripRef passage="Matt. xii. 40" id="ii.xviii.v.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Matt|12|40|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Matt.12.40">Matt. xii, 40</scripRef>. Yea, she might fast all that day too: for it is probable
she went not to the king 'till he had dined; when she supposed she might
find him in the most mild and pleasant humour, and then returned to her
apartment, where she fasted 'till the evening.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="72.06%" prev="ii.xviii.v.ii" next="ii.xviii.vi.i" id="ii.xviii.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther V" id="ii.xviii.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="72.06%" prev="ii.xviii.vi" next="ii.xviii.vi.ii" id="ii.xviii.vi.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.i-p1">Esther finding favour with the king, invites him and
Haman to a banquet, ver. 1-5. She invites them to a second, ver. 6-8.
Haman makes a gallows for Mordecai, ver. 9-14.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="72.07%" prev="ii.xviii.vi.i" next="ii.xviii.vii" id="ii.xviii.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p1">2. Held out - In testimony that he pardoned her
presumption, and was ready to grant her petition. Touched - In token of
her thankful acceptance of the king's favour, and of her reverence and
submission.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p2">3. It shall be given - God in his providence often
prevents the fears and outdoes the hopes of his servants. To the half of
the kingdom - A proverbial expression: that is, nothing in reason shall
be denied.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p3">4. Haman - Whom she invited, that by shewing such respect
to the king's great favourite, she might insinuate herself the more into
the king's affection; and, that if she saw fit, she might then present
her request to the king.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p4">6. Of wine - So called, because it consisted not of
meats, which probably the king had plentifully eaten before, but of
fruits and wines; which banquets were very frequent among the
Persians.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p5">8. Tomorrow - I will acquaint thee with my humble
request. She did not present her petition at this time, but delayed it
'till the next meeting; either because she was a little daunted with the
king's presence, or, because she would farther engage the king's
affection to her, and would also intimate to him that her petition was
of a more than ordinary nature: but principally by direction of Divine
providence, which took away her courage of utterance for this time, that
she might have a better opportunity for it the next time, by that great
accident which happened before it.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p6">9. Nor moved - To shew how little he feared him, and that
he had a firm confidence in his God, that he would deliver him and his
people in this great exigency.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p7">10. Refrained - From taking present vengeance upon
Mordecai, which he might easily have effected, either by his own, or any
of his servants hands, without any fear of inconveniency to himself. But
herein God's wise and powerful providence appeared, in disposing Haman's
heart, contrary to his own inclination, and making him, as it were, to
put fetters upon his own hands.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p8">12. Am I - Thus he makes that matter of glorying which
was the occasion of his utter ruin. So ignorant are the wisest men, and
subject to fatal mistakes, rejoicing when they have most cause of fear,
and sorrowing for those things which tend to joy and comfort.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p9">13. Availeth - Gives me no content. Such torment did his
envy and malice bring upon him. Sitting - Enjoying that honour and
privilege without disturbance, and denying me the worship due to me by
the king's command. Thus tho' proud men have much to their mind, if they
have not all to their mind, it is nothing. The thousandth part of what
Haman had, would give a modest, humble man, as much happiness as he
expects to receive from anything under the sun. And Haman as
passionately complains, as if he was in the lowest depth of poverty!</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vi.ii-p10">14. Fifty cubits - That it may be more conspicuous to
all, and thereby be more disgraceful to Mordecai, and strike all Haman's
enemies with a greater dread of despising or opposing him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="72.12%" prev="ii.xviii.vi.ii" next="ii.xviii.vii.i" id="ii.xviii.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther VI" id="ii.xviii.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="72.12%" prev="ii.xviii.vii" next="ii.xviii.vii.ii" id="ii.xviii.vii.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.vii.i-p1">Providence recommends Mordecai to the king's favour, ver.
1- 3. Haman is constrained publickly to honour him thro' the city, ver.
4-11. His friends foretell his doom, ver. 12, 13, He goes to the
banquet, ver. 14.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="72.12%" prev="ii.xviii.vii.i" next="ii.xviii.viii" id="ii.xviii.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.vii.ii-p1">1. Sleep - How vain are all the contrivances of foolish
man against the wise and omnipotent God, who hath the hearts and hands
of kings and all men perfectly at his disposal, and can by such trivial
accidents (as they are accounted) change their minds, and produce such
terrible effects. Were read - His mind being troubled he knew not how,
nor why, he chuses this for a diversion, God putting this thought into
him, for otherwise he might have diverted himself, as he used to do,
with his wives or concubines, or voices and instruments of musick, which
were far more agreeable to his temper.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vii.ii-p2">3. Nothing - He hath had no recompence for this great and
good service. Which might either happen through the king's
forgetfulness; or through the envy of the courtiers; or because he was a
Jew, and therefore odious and contemptible.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vii.ii-p3">4. Haman - Early in the morning, because his malice would
not suffer him to sleep; and he was impatient 'till he had executed his
revenge; and was resolved to watch for the very first opportunity of
speaking to the king, before he was engaged in other matters. Outward
court - Where he waited; because it was dangerous to come into the inner
court without special license, chap. iv, 11.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vii.ii-p4">6. Man - He names none, because he would have the more
impartial answer. And probably knew nothing of the difference between
Haman and Mordecai. Thought - As he had great reason to do, because of
the favour which the king had shewed to him above all others.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vii.ii-p5">8. Royal apparel - His outward garment, which was made of
purple, interwoven with gold, as Justin and Cartius relate.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vii.ii-p6">12. Gate - To his former place; shewing that as he was
not overwhelmed by Haman's threats, so he was not puffed up with this
honour. Cover'd - In token of his shame and grief for his unexpected
disappointment, and for the great honour done to his abhorred adversary,
by his own hands, and with his own public disgrace.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vii.ii-p7">13. Wise men - The magicians, whom after the Persian
manner he had called together to consult upon this strange
emergency.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.vii.ii-p8">14. To bring - Who was now slack to go thither, by reason
of the great dejection of his own mind.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="72.16%" prev="ii.xviii.vii.ii" next="ii.xviii.viii.i" id="ii.xviii.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther VII" id="ii.xviii.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="72.16%" prev="ii.xviii.viii" next="ii.xviii.viii.ii" id="ii.xviii.viii.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.viii.i-p1">Esther petitions for her life, and the lives of her
people, ver. 1- 4. She tells the king that Haman is the man who designed
her ruin, ver. 5, 6. By the king's order, he is hanged on the gallows he
had prepared for Mordecai, ver. 7-10.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="72.16%" prev="ii.xviii.viii.i" next="ii.xviii.ix" id="ii.xviii.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.viii.ii-p1">3. My life - It is my only request, that thou wouldst not
give me up to the malice of that man who designs to take away my life.
Even a stranger, a criminal, shall be permitted to petition for his
life. But that a friend, a wife, a queen, should have occasion to make
such a petition, was very affecting.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.viii.ii-p2">4. Sold - By the cruelty of that man who offered a great
sum to purchase our destruction. Countervail - His ten thousand talents
would not repair the king's loss, in the customs and tributes which the
king receives from the Jews, within his dominions.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.viii.ii-p3">5. Who, &amp;c. - The expressions are short and doubled,
as proceeding from a discomposed and enraged mind. Durst - That is, to
circumvent me, and procure a decree, whereby not only my estate should
be so much impaired, and so many of my innocent subjects destroyed, but
my queen also involved in the same destruction. We sometimes startle at
that evil, which we ourselves are chargeable with. Ahasuerus is amazed
at that wickedness, which he himself was guilty of. For he consented to
the bloody edict. So that Esther might have said, Thou art the man!</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.viii.ii-p4">6. Afraid - And it was time for him to fear, when the
queen was his prosecutor, the king his judge, his own conscience a
witness against him. And the surprising turns of providence that very
morning, could not but increase his fear.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.viii.ii-p5">7. Went - As disdaining the company and sight of so
audacious a person: to cool and allay his troubled and inflamed spirits,
and to consider what punishment was fit to be inflicted upon him. He saw
- By the violent commotion of the king's mind.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.viii.ii-p6">8. Bed - On which the queen sat at meat. Force - Will he
attempt my queen's chastity, as he hath already attempted her life! He
speaks not this out of real jealousy, but from an exasperated mind,
which takes all occasions to vent itself against the person who gave the
provocation. They - The king's and queen's chamberlains attending upon
them. Covered - That the king might not be offended or grieved with the
sight of a person whom he now loathed: and because they looked upon him
as a condemned person; for the faces of such used to be covered.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="72.20%" prev="ii.xviii.viii.ii" next="ii.xviii.ix.i" id="ii.xviii.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther VIII" id="ii.xviii.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="72.20%" prev="ii.xviii.ix" next="ii.xviii.ix.ii" id="ii.xviii.ix.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.i-p1">The estate of Haman is given to Esther, ver. 1, 2. Esther
petitions the king, to reverse the edict against the Jews, ver. 3-6.
They are authorized to defend themselves, ver. 7-14. The Jews and their
friends rejoice, ver. 15-17.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="72.21%" prev="ii.xviii.ix.i" next="ii.xviii.x" id="ii.xviii.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p1">1. The house - With all his goods and estate, which being
justly forfeited to the king, he no less justly bestows it upon the
queen, to compensate the danger to which Haman had exposed her. Came -
Was by the queen's desire admitted into the king's presence, and family,
and, as it seems, made one of the seven princes. Had told - How nearly
he was related to her: which 'till this time she had wisely
concealed.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p2">2. Ring - That ring which he had formerly given to Haman
he now gives to Mordecai, and with it that power whereof this ring was a
sign, making him, as Haman had been, the keeper of his signet. Set - As
her steward, to manage that great estate for her as he thought
fittest.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p3">3. To put - To repeal that cruel decree.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p4">5. If &amp;c. - She uses various expressions, that she
might confirm the king's favour, by such a full submission to his good
pleasure. Haman - She prudently takes off the hatefulness of the action
from the king, and lay's it upon Haman, who had for his own ends
contrived the whole business, and circumvented the king in it.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p5">8. Reverse - For this reason he could not recall the
former letters, because they were irrevocable by the law of the Medes
and Persians. How much more prudent is our constitution, that no law
whatever can be established as to be unrepealable? It is God's
prerogative, not to repent, and to say what can never be altered.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p6">9. Then - Which was above two months after the former
decree. All which time God suffered the Jews to lie under the error of
this dreadful day, that they might be more throughly humbled for, and
purged from those many and great sins under which they lay; that they
might be convinced of their great sin and folly in the many offers they
had had of returning to their native country, by which means being
dispersed in the several parts of this vast dominion, they were like to
be a very easy prey to their enemies, whereas their brethren in Judea
were in a better capacity to preserve themselves: and for the greater
illustration of God's glorious power, and wisdom, and goodness, in
giving his people such an admirable and unexpected deliverance.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p7">10. Riders - Which were not employed in sending the
former letter: but this coming later required more care and speed, that
the Jews might be eased from their present fears, and have time to
provide for their own defense.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p8">11. To stand - To fight for the defense of their lives
against all that should seek to destroy them. The power - Either
governors or governed, without any exception either of age, dignity, or
sex, Both little ones and women - Which is here added, to strike the
greater terror into their enemies; and according to the laws and customs
of this kingdom; whereby children were punished for their parents
offenses: yet we read nothing in the execution of this decree of the
slaughter of women or children, nor is it probable, they would kill
their innocent children, who were so indulgent to their families, as not
to meddle with the spoil.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p9">15. Great crown - Which the chief of the Persian princes
were permitted to wear but with sufficient distinction from the king's
crown. The city - Not only Jews, but the greatest number of the
citizens, who by the law of nature abhorred bloody counsels, and had a
complacency in acts of mercy.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.ix.ii-p10">16. Joy - This explains the former metaphor by two words
expressing the same thing, to denote the greatness of the joy. honour -
Instead of that contempt under which they had lain.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="72.27%" prev="ii.xviii.ix.ii" next="ii.xviii.x.i" id="ii.xviii.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther IX" id="ii.xviii.x-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="72.27%" prev="ii.xviii.x" next="ii.xviii.x.ii" id="ii.xviii.x.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.x.i-p1">The Jews slay their enemies, ver. 1-11. A second day is
granted them, ver. 12-19. A yearly feast is instituted, in memory of
this great deliverance, ver. 20-32</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="72.27%" prev="ii.xviii.x.i" next="ii.xviii.xi" id="ii.xviii.x.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p1">2. No man - Their enemies, though they did take up arms
against them, yet were easily conquered and destroyed by them.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p2">6. Shushan - In the city so called. Slew - Whom they knew
to be such as would watch all opportunities to destroy them; which also
they might possibly now attempt to do.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p3">10. But, &amp;c. - Because they would leave it to their
children, that it might appear what they did was not done out of malice,
or covetousness, but out of mere necessity, and by that great law of
self-preservation.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p4">12. What - In which doubtless many more were slain. So
that I have fully granted thy petition. And yet, if thou hast any thing
farther to ask, I am ready to grant it.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p5">13. Let it, &amp;c. - To kill their implacable enemies.
For it is not improbable that the greatest and worst of them had hidden
themselves for that day; after which, the commission granted to the Jews
being expired, they confidently returned to their homes. Hanged - They
were slain before; now let their bodies be hanged on their father's
gallows, for their greater infamy, and the terror of all others who
shall presume to abuse the king in like manner, or to persuade him to
execute such cruelties upon his subjects.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p6">26. Pur - This Persian word signifies a lot, because
Haman had by lot determined this time to be the time of the Jews
destruction.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p7">27. As joined - Gentile Proselytes; who were obliged to
submit to other of the Jewish laws, and therefore to this also; the
rather because they enjoyed the benefit of this day's deliverance;
without which the Jewish nation and religion had been in a great
measure, if not wholly, extinct. According - According to that writing
which was drawn up by Mordecai, and afterwards confirmed by the consent
of the Jews.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p8">29. Wrote - The former letter, ver. 20, did only
recommend but this enjoins the observation of this solemnity: because
this was not only Mordecai's act, but the act of all the Jews, binding
themselves and posterity.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p9">30. Peace - With peace, friendship and kindness to his
brethren, and truth, sincerity.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p10">31. Cry - For those great calamities which were decreed
to all the Jews, and for the removing of which, not only Esther, and the
Jews in Shushan, but all other Jews in all places, did doubtless fly to
God by fasting, and strong cries.</p>

<p id="ii.xviii.x.ii-p11">32. Either - Who had received authority from the king.
The book - In the records which the Jews kept of their most memorable
passages.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="72.31%" prev="ii.xviii.x.ii" next="ii.xviii.xi.i" id="ii.xviii.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Esther X" id="ii.xviii.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Esth|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Esth.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xviii.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="72.31%" prev="ii.xviii.xi" next="ii.xviii.xi.ii" id="ii.xviii.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xviii.xi.i-p1">The greatness of Ahasuerus, and of Mordecai, ver.
1-3.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="72.31%" prev="ii.xviii.xi.i" next="ii.xix" id="ii.xviii.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.xviii.xi.ii-p1">2. Chronicles, &amp;c. - These are lost long since, and
buried in oblivion, while the sacred writings remain throughout the
world. When the kingdoms of men, monarchs and their monarchies are
destroyed, and their memorial is perished with them, the kingdom of God
among men, and the records of that kingdom, shall remain as the days of
heaven.</p>
</div4>
</div3>
</div2>

<div2 title="NOTES ON THE BOOK OF JOB" progress="72.32%" prev="ii.xviii.xi.ii" next="ii.xix.i" id="ii.xix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job" id="ii.xix-p0.1" />
<h2 id="ii.xix-p0.2">NOTES ON THE BOOK OF JOB</h2>

<div3 title="Introduction to Job" progress="72.32%" prev="ii.xix" next="ii.xix.ii" id="ii.xix.i">

<p id="ii.xix.i-p1">THE preceding books of scripture are, for the most part,
plain and easy narratives, which he that runs may read and understand:
but in the five poetical books, on which we are now entering, Job,
Psalms, Proverbs, Ecclesiastes, and Solomon's Song, are many things hard
to be understood. These therefore require a more close application of
mind, which yet the treasures they contain will abundantly recompence.
The former books were mostly historical: these are doctrinal and
devotional. And they are wrote in verse, according to the ancient rules
of versifying, tho' not in rhythm, nor according to the rules of latter
tongues. Job is a kind of heroic poem; the book of Psalms a collection
of sacred odes, Solomon's song, a Divine pastoral. They are all
poetical, yet serious and full of majesty. They have a poetic force and
flame, without poetic fury, move the affections, without corrupting the
imagination; and while they gratify the ear, improve the mind, and
profit the more by pleasing. We have here much of God, his infinite
pefections, and his government both of the world, and of the church. And
we have much of Christ, who is the spring, and soul, and center of
revealed religion. Here is what may enlighten our understandings, and
acquaint us with the deep things of God. And this divine light may bring
into the soul a divine fire, which will kindle and inflame devout
affections, on which wings we may soar upwards, until we enter into the
holiest. We are certain that the book of Job is a true history. That
there was such a man as Job, undeniably appears, from his being
mentioned by the prophet, together with Noah and Daniel, <scripRef passage="Ezek xiv. 14" id="ii.xix.i-p1.1" parsed="|Ezek|14|14|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.14.14">Ezek xiv, 14</scripRef>, and the narrative we have of his prosperity and piety, his
strange afflictions and exemplary patience, the substance of his
conferences with his friends, and God's discourse with him out of the
whirlwind, with his return to a prosperous condition, are no doubt
exactly true. We are sure also this book is very ancient, probably of
equal date with the book of Genesis itself. It is likely, Job was of the
posterity of Nahor, Abraham's brother, whose first-born was Uz, and in
whose family religion was kept up, as appears <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxi. 53" id="ii.xix.i-p1.2" parsed="|Gen|31|53|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.31.53">Gen. xxxi, 53</scripRef>, where God is called not only the God of Abraham, but the
God of Nahor. He lived before sacrifices were confined to one altar,
before the general apostacy of the nations, and while God was known by
the name of God Almighty, more than by the name of Jehovah: for he is
called Shaddai, the Almighty, above thirty times in this book. And that
he lived before (probably very little before) the deliverance of the
children of Israel out of Egypt, we may gather from hence, that there is
no allusion at all to that grand event throughout the whole book. In
this noble poem we have,</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.xix.i-p2">1. A monument of primitive theology;</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.xix.i-p3">2. A specimen of Gentile piety: for Job was
not of the promised seed, no Israelite, no proselyte:</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.xix.i-p4">3. An exposition of the book of providence,
and a clear solution of man difficult passages therein:</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.xix.i-p5">4. A great example of patience and close
adherence to God in the deepest calamities: and</p>

<p class="List1" id="ii.xix.i-p6">5. An illustrious type of Christ, emptied and
humbled, in order to his greater glory. In this book we have, an account
of Job's sufferings, chap. 1, 2, Not without a mixture of human frailty,
chap. 3. A dispute between him and his three friends, chap. 4-31. The
interposal of Elihu, and of God himself, chap. 32-41. The end of all in
Job's prosperity, chap. 42.</p>
</div3>

<div3 title="I" progress="72.38%" prev="ii.xix.i" next="ii.xix.ii.i" id="ii.xix.ii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job I" id="ii.xix.ii-p0.1" parsed="|Job|1|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.1" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.ii-p0.2">I</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter I" progress="72.38%" prev="ii.xix.ii" next="ii.xix.ii.ii" id="ii.xix.ii.i">

<p id="ii.xix.ii.i-p1">Job's piety, children, substance, ver. 1-5. Satan obtains
leave to try him, ver. 6-12. His oxen, sheep, camels and servants
destroyed, ver. 13-17. His sons and daughters killed, ver. 18, 19. His
patience and piety, ver. 20-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter I" progress="72.39%" prev="ii.xix.ii.i" next="ii.xix.iii" id="ii.xix.ii.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p1">1. Uz - Part of Arabia. Perfect - Not legally or exactly,
but as to his sincere intentions, hearty affections, and diligent
endeavours to perform all his duties to God and men. Upright - Hebrew.
right, exact and regular in all his dealings, with men; one of an
unblameable conversation. Feared - One truly pious, and devoted to God.
Eschewed - Carefully avoiding all sin against God or men.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p2">3. Camels - Camels in these parts were very numerous, and
very useful, both for carrying burdens in these hot and dry countries,
as being able to endure thirst much better than other creatures, and for
service in war. Asses - He-asses also may be included in this
expression, because the greatest part of them (from which the
denomination is usually taken) were she asses. The greatest - That lived
in those parts. The account of his piety and prosperity comes before the
account of his afflictions, to shew that neither of these will secure us
from the common, no, nor from the uncommon calamities of human life.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p3">4. Feasted - To testify and maintain their brotherly
love. His day - Each his appointed day, perhaps his birth-day, or the
first day of the month.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p4">5. When - When each of them had had his turn. Satisfied -
He exhorted them to examine their own consciences, to repent of any
thing, which had been amiss in their feasting, and compose their minds
for employments of a more solemn nature. Early - Thereby shewing his
ardent zeal in God's service. May be - His zeal for God's glory, and his
true love to his children, made him jealous. Cursed - Not in a gross
manner, which it is not probable either that they should do, or that Job
should suspect it concerning them, but despised or dishonoured God; for
both Hebrew and Greek words signifies cursing, are sometimes used to
note only, reviling or setting light by a person. Hearts - By slight and
low thoughts of God, or by neglecting to give God the praise for the
mercies which they enjoyed. Thus - It was his constant course at the end
of every feasting time, to offer a sacrifice for each. Parents should be
particular in their addresses to God, for the several branches of their
family; praying for each child, according to his particular temper,
genius and disposition.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p5">6. A day - A certain time appointed by God. The sons -
The holy angels, so called, chap. xxxviii, 7 <scripRef passage="Dan. iii. 25, 28" id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p5.1" parsed="|Dan|3|25|0|0;|Dan|3|28|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Dan.3.25 Bible:Dan.3.28">Dan. iii, 25, 28</scripRef>, because of their creation by God, for their resemblance of
him in power, and dignity, and holiness, and for their filial affection
and obedience, to him. Before - Before his throne, to receive his
commands, and to give him an account of their negotiations. But you must
not think that these things are to be understood literally; it is only a
parabolical representation of that great truth, that God by his wise and
holy providence governs all the actions of men and devils: It being
usual with the great God to condescend to our shallow capacities, and to
express himself, as the Jews phrase it, in the language of the sons of
men. And it is likewise intimated, that the affairs of earth are much
the subject of the counsels of the unseen world. That world is dark to
us: but we lie open to it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p6">9. For nought - Out of pure love and respect to thee? No.
It is policy, not piety, that makes him good; he doth not serve thee,
but serveth himself of thee, serving thee for his own ends.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p7">12. Behold, &amp;c. - It seems strange, that, God should
give Satan such a permission as this. But he did it for his own glory,
for the honour of Job, for the explanation of providence, and the
encouragement of his afflicted people in all ages.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p8">14. Messenger, &amp;c. - One messenger immediately
followed another; Satan so ordering by God's permission, that there
might seem to be more than ordinary displeasure of God against him in
his troubles, and that he might not have leisure to recollect himself,
but be overwhelmed by a complication of calamities.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p9">15. Sabeans - A people of Arabia, who led a wandering
life, and lived by robbery and spoil. I - Whom Satan spared, that Job
might have speedy and certain intelligence of his calamity.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p10">16. The fire of God - As thunder is the voice of God, so
lightning is his fire. How terrible then were the tidings of this
destruction, which came immediately from the hand of God! And seemed to
shew, that God was angry at his very offerings, and would receive no
more from his hands.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p11">17. Chaldeans - Who also lived upon spoil, as Xenephon
and others observe.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p12">19. The young men - This was the greatest of Job's
losses, and therefore Satan reserved it to the last, that if the other
provocations failed, this might make him curse God. They died by a wind
of the devils raising, but which seemed to be the immediate hand of God.
And they were taken away, when he had the most need of them, to comfort
him under all his other losses. Such miserable comforters are creatures:
in God we have a constant and sufficient help.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p13">20. Shaved - Caused his hair to be shaved or cut off,
which was then an usual ceremony in mourning. Worshipped - Instead of
cursing God, which Satan said he would do, he adored him, and gave him
the glory of his sovereignty, of his justice, and of his goodness also,
in this most severe dispensation.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p14">21. Naked - I brought none of these things with me, when
I came out of my mother's womb into the world, but I received them from
the hand of God, who hath now required his own again. Return thither - I
shall be as rich when I die as I was when I was born, and therefore have
reason to be contented with my condition, which also is the common lot
of all men. Into the lap of our common mother, the earth, as the weary
child lays its head in its mother's bosom. We go out of the world naked;
the body doth, tho' the sanctified soul goes clothed. (<scripRef passage="2Cor v. 3" id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p14.1" parsed="|2Cor|5|3|0|0" osisRef="Bible:2Cor.5.3">2Cor v, 3</scripRef>.) Death strips us of all our enjoyments: clothing can
neither warm nor adorn a dead body. Taken - He hath taken away nothing
but his own, and what he so gave that he reserved the supreme disposal
of in his own hand. And what is it to me, by what hand he that gives,
resumes what he gave?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ii.ii-p15">22. Charged - Hebrew. not imputed folly to God; so far
was he from blaspheming God, that he did not entertain any dishonourable
thought of God, as if he had done anything unworthy of his infinite
wisdom, or justice, or goodness, but heartily acquiesced in his good
pleasure, and in his righteous though sharp proceedings against him.
Discontent and impatience do in effect impute folly to God. Against the
workings of these we should carefully watch, acknowledging that God has
done well, but we have done foolishly.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="II" progress="72.50%" prev="ii.xix.ii.ii" next="ii.xix.iii.i" id="ii.xix.iii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job II" id="ii.xix.iii-p0.1" parsed="|Job|2|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.2" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.iii-p0.2">II</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter II" progress="72.50%" prev="ii.xix.iii" next="ii.xix.iii.ii" id="ii.xix.iii.i">

<p id="ii.xix.iii.i-p1">Satan moves for another trial of Job, which God permits,
ver. 1- 6. Satan smites him with boils from head to foot, ver. 7, 8. He
is tempted by his wife, but resists the temptation, ver. 9, 10 His
friends come to comfort him, ver. 11-13.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter II" progress="72.51%" prev="ii.xix.iii.i" next="ii.xix.iv" id="ii.xix.iii.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p1">3. Still - Notwithstanding all his afflictions, and thy
suggestion to the contrary. Movedst - This, as the rest of this
representation, is not to be understood literally: But the design is to
signify both the devil's restless malice in promoting man's misery and
God's permission of it for wise and holy ends.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p2">4. Skin, &amp;c. - The sense is, this is so far from
being an evidence of Job's sincere and generous piety, that it is only
an act of mere self- love; he is contented with the loss of his estate,
and children too, so long as he sleeps in a whole skin; and he is well
pleased, that thou wilt accept of these a ransom in his stead; and it is
not true patience which makes him seem to bear his crosses so
submissively, but policy, that he may appease thy wrath against him, and
prevent those farther plagues, which, for his hypocrisy, he fears thou
wilt otherwise bring upon his own carcase.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p3">6. In thine hand - If God did not chain up the roaring
lion, how soon would he devour us! As far as he permits the wrath of
Satan and wicked men, to proceed against his people, he will make it
turn to his praise and theirs, and the remainder thereof he will
restrain. Job, in being thus maligned of Satan, was a type of Christ. He
had permission to bruise his heel, to touch his bone and his flesh; yea,
and his life also; because by dying he was to do what Job could not do,
to destroy him that had the power of death.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p4">7. Boils - Like those inflicted upon the Egyptians, which
are expressed by the same word, and threatened to apostate Israelites, <scripRef passage="Deut. xxviii. 27" id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p4.1" parsed="|Deut|28|27|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Deut.28.27">Deut. xxviii, 27</scripRef>, whereby he was made loathsome to himself, and to his
nearest relations, and filled with consuming pains in his body, and no
less torments and anguish in his mind.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p5">8. Scrape - This he did not with soft linen clothes,
either because he had not now a sufficient quantity of them; or because
therein he must have had the help of others who abhorred to come near
him. Nor with his own hands or fingers, which were also ulcerous, and so
unfit for that use; but with potsherds, either because they were next at
hand, and ready for his present use; or in token of his deep humiliation
under God's hand, which made him decline all things that favoured of
tenderness and delicacy. Hebrew. in dust or ashes, as mourners used to
do. If God lay him among the ashes, there he will contentedly sit down.
A low spirit becomes low circumstances, and will help to reconcile us to
them.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p6">9. Then said his wife - Whom Satan spared, to be a
troubler and tempter to him. It is his policy, to send his temptations
by the hands of those that are dear to us. We must therefore carefully
watch, that we be not drawn to any evil, by them whom we love and value
the most. Die - I see thou art set upon blessing of God, thou blessest
God for giving, and thou blessest God for taking away, and thou art
still blessing God for thy loathsome diseases, and he rewards thee
accordingly, giving thee more and more of that kind of mercy for which
thou blessest him. Go on therefore in thy generous course, and bless
God, and die as a fool dieth.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p7">10. Shall we - Shall we poor worms give laws to our
supreme Lord, and oblige him never to afflict us? And shall not those
great and manifold mercies, which from time to time God hath given us,
compensate these short afflictions? Ought we not to bless God for those
mercies which we did not deserve; and contentedly bear those corrections
which we do deserve. And if we receive so much good for the body, shall
we not receive some good for our souls? That is, some affliction,
whereby we may be made partakers of his holiness? Let murmuring
therefore, as well as boasting, be forever excluded. Sin with his lips -
By any reflections upon God, by any impatient or unbecoming
expression.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p8">11. They - Who were persons eminent for birth and
quality, for wisdom and knowledge, and for the profession of the true
religion, being probably of the posterity of Abraham, a-kin to Job, and
living in the same country. Eliphaz descended from Teman, the grandson
of Esau, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxxvi. 11" id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p8.1" parsed="|Gen|36|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.36.11">Gen. xxxvi, 11</scripRef>. Bildad probably from Shuah, Abraham's son by Keturah, <scripRef passage="Gen. xxv. 2" id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p8.2" parsed="|Gen|25|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.25.2">Gen. xxv, 2</scripRef>. Zophar is thought to be same with Zepho, (<scripRef passage="Gen. xxxvi. 11" id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p8.3" parsed="|Gen|36|11|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.36.11">Gen. xxxvi, 11</scripRef>.) a descendant from Esau. The preserving of so much wisdom
and piety among those who were not children of the promise, was an happy
presage of God's grace to the Gentiles, when the partition wall should
be taken down.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iii.ii-p9">13. Upon the ground - In the posture of mourners
condoling with him. Seven days - Which was the usual time of mourning
for the dead, and therefore proper both for Job's children, and for Job
himself, who was in a manner dead, while he lived: not that they
continued in this posture so long together, which the necessities of
nature could not bear; but they spent the greatest part of that time in
sitting with him, and silent mourning over him. None spake - About his
afflictions and the causes of them. The reason of this silence was the
greatness of their grief for him, and their surprize and astonishment at
his condition; because they thought it convenient to give him time to
vent his own sorrows, and because as yet they knew not what to say to
him: for though they had ever esteemed him to be a truly good man, and
came with full purpose to comfort him, yet the prodigious greatness of
his miseries, and that hand of God which they perceived in them, made
them now question his sincerity, so that they could not comfort him as
they had intended, and yet were loth to grieve him with reproofs.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="III" progress="72.60%" prev="ii.xix.iii.ii" next="ii.xix.iv.i" id="ii.xix.iv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job III" id="ii.xix.iv-p0.1" parsed="|Job|3|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.3" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.iv-p0.2">III</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter III" progress="72.60%" prev="ii.xix.iv" next="ii.xix.iv.ii" id="ii.xix.iv.i">

<p id="ii.xix.iv.i-p1">We have here Job cursing his birth day, and complaining
that he was born, ver. 1-10. Complaining that he did not die as soon as
he was born, ver. 11-19. Complaining that his life was continued, now he
was in misery, ver. 20-26.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter III" progress="72.61%" prev="ii.xix.iv.i" next="ii.xix.v" id="ii.xix.iv.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p1">1. His day - His birth-day, in vain do some endeavour to
excuse this and the following speeches of Job, who afterwards is
reproved by God, and severely accuseth himself for them, chap. xxxviii,
2; xl, 4; xiii, 3, 6. And yet he does not proceed so far as to curse
God, but makes the devil a liar: but although he does not break forth
into direct reproaches of God, yet he makes indirect reflections upon
his providence. His curse was sinful, both because it was vain, being
applied to a thing, which was not capable of blessing and cursing, and
because it cast a blame upon God for bringing that day, and for giving
him life on that day.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p2">3. Let the day - Let the remembrance of that day be
utterly lost.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p3">4. Darkness - I wish the sun had never risen upon that
day, or, which is all one, that it had never been; and whensoever that
day returns, I wish it may be black, and gloomy, and uncomfortable.
Regard - From heaven, by causing the light of the sun which is in heaven
to shine upon it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p4">5. Death - A black and dark shadow like that of the place
of the dead, which is a land of darkness. Slain - Take away its beauty
and glory. Terrify - That is, men in it. Let it be always observed as a
frightful and dismal day.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p5">6. Darkness - Constant and extraordinary darkness,
without the least glimmering of light from the moon or stars. Be joined
- Reckoned as one, or a part of one of them.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p6">8. The day - Their birth-day: when their afflictions move
them to curse their own birth-day, let them remember mine also, and
bestow some curses upon it. Mourning - Who are full of sorrow, and
always ready to pour out their cries, and tears, and complaints.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p7">9. The stars - Let the stars, which are the glory and
beauty of the night, be covered with thick darkness, and that both in
the evening twilight, when the stars begin to shine; and also in the
farther progress of the night, even 'till the morning dawns. Look - Let
its darkness be aggravated with the disappointment of its expectations
of light. He ascribes sense or reasoning to the night, by a poetical
fiction, usual in all writers. Dawning - Hebrew. the eye-lids of the
day, the morning-star which ushers in the day, and the beginning, and
progress of the morning light, let this whole natural day, consisting of
night and day, be blotted out of the catalogue of days.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p8">10. It - The night or the day: to which those things are
ascribed which were done by others in them, as is frequent in poetical
writings. Womb - That it might never have brought me forth. Nor hid -
Because it did not keep me from entering into this miserable life, and
seeing, or experiencing, these bitter sorrows.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p9">12. The knees - Why did the midwife or nurse receive and
lay me upon her knees, and not suffer me to fall upon the bare ground,
'till death had taken me out of this miserable world, into which their
cruel kindness hath betrayed me? Why did the breasts prevent me from
perishing through hunger, or supply me that should have what to suck?
Thus Job unthankfully despises these wonderful mercies of God towards
poor helpless infants.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p10">14. Kings - I had then been as happy as the proudest
monarchs, who after all their great achievements and enjoyments, go down
into their graves. Built - Who to shew their wealth and power, or to
leave behind them a glorious name, rebuilt ruined cities, or built new
cities and palaces, in places where before there was mere solitude and
wasteness.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p11">16. Hidden - Undiscerned and unregarded. Born before the
due time. Been - In the land of the living.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p12">17. There - In the grave. The wicked - The great
oppressors and troublers of the world cease from their vexations, rapins
and murders. Weary - Those who were here molested and tired out with
their tyrannies, now quietly sleep with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p13">18. The oppressor - Or, taskmaster, who urges and forces
them to work by cruel threatenings and stripes. Job meddles not here
with their eternal state after death, of which he speaks hereafter, but
only their freedom from worldly troubles, which is the sole matter of
his present discourse.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p14">19. Small and great - Persons of all qualities and
conditions. Are there - In the same place and state, all those
distinctions being forever abolished. A good reason, why those who have
power should use it moderately, and those that are in subjection should
take it patiently.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p15">20. Light - The light of life. Bitter - Unto those to
whom life itself is bitter and burdensome. Life is called light, because
it is pleasant and serviceable for walking and working; and this light
is said to be given us, because it would be lost, if it were not daily
renewed to us by a fresh gift.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p16">21. Dig - Desire with as much earnestness as men dig for
treasure: but it is observable, Job durst not do anything to hasten or
procure his death: notwithstanding all his miseries, he was contented to
wait all the days of his appointed time, 'till his change came, chap.
xiv, 14.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p17">22. Glad, &amp;c. - To be thus impatient of life, for the
sake of the trouble we meet with, is not only unnatural in itself, but
ungrateful to the giver of life, and shews a sinful indulgence of our
own passion. Let it be our great and constant care, to get ready for
another world: and then let us leave it to God, to order the
circumstances of our removal thither.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p18">23. Hid - From him; who knows not his way, which way to
turn himself, what course to take to comfort himself in his miseries.
Hedged in - Whom God hath put as it were in a prison, so that he can see
no way or possibility of escape.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p19">24. Before, &amp;c. - Hebrew. before the face of my
bread, all the time I am eating, I fall into sighing and weeping,
because I am obliged to eat, and to support this wretched life, and
because of my uninterrupted pains of body and of mind, which do not
afford me one quiet moment. Roarings - My loud outcries, more befitting
a lion than a man. Poured out - With great abundance, and irresistible
violence, and incessant continuance, as waters flow in a river, or as
they break the banks, and overflow the ground.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p20">25. Feared - Even in the time of my prosperity, I was
full of fears, considering the variety of God's providences, the
changeableness of this vain world, God's justice, and the sinfulness of
all mankind. And these fears of mine, were not in vain, but are
justified by my present calamities.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.iv.ii-p21">26. Quiet - I did not misbehave myself in prosperity,
abusing it by presumption, and security, but I lived circumspectly,
walking humbly with God, and working out my salvation with fear and
trembling. Therefore in this sense also, his way was hid, he knew not
why God contended with him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IV" progress="72.72%" prev="ii.xix.iv.ii" next="ii.xix.v.i" id="ii.xix.v">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job IV" id="ii.xix.v-p0.1" parsed="|Job|4|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.4" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.v-p0.2">IV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IV" progress="72.72%" prev="ii.xix.v" next="ii.xix.v.ii" id="ii.xix.v.i">

<p id="ii.xix.v.i-p1">Eliphaz owns Job's former usefulness, but infers from his
present state and behaviour, that he was an hypocrite, ver. 1-6. He
affirms that God never afflicts man, but for his wickedness, ver. 7-11.
He confirms his assertion, by the words he heard in a vision, ver.
12-21. By all this he aims to make Job both penitent and patient under
his sufferings.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IV" progress="72.73%" prev="ii.xix.v.i" next="ii.xix.vi" id="ii.xix.v.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p1">2. If we, &amp;c. - He speaks with great modesty. He will
not undertake the cause alone, but joins his friends with him. He will
not promise much, but only assay, or try if he could propose any thing
pertinent to Job's case. Withhold - When he hears such words from such a
person as thou art.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p2">4. Feeble knees - Such as were weak hearted, and fainting
under their trials.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p3">6. Thy fear - We now plainly see what was the nature of
thy fear of God, thy confidence in him, the uprightness of thy ways, and
thy hope in God's mercy. Thy present carriage discovers that it was but
mere talk and appearance.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p4">7. Innocent - Therefore thou art guilty of some great,
though secret crimes, and thy sin hath now found thee out. Cut off - By
the sickle of Divine vengeance before his time, which is like to be thy
case. Eliphaz here advances another argument to prove Job an hypocrite;
taken not only from his impatience under afflictions, but from his
afflictions themselves.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p5">8. Even - As thou hast never seen any example of a
righteous man cut off, so I have seen many of wicked men cut off for
their wickedness. They - They that designedly work wickedness, first
preparing themselves for it, and then continuing to execute it, as
husbandmen first plow the ground, and then cast in the feed. Reap - The
fruit of their iniquity, the just punishment of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p6">9. The blast - Of his nostrils, as it follows; by his
anger, which in men shews itself, in the nostrils, by hot and frequent
breathings there, by a secret, but mighty judgment of God, they are
blown away as chaff by the wind.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p7">10. The roaring - Nor can they escape, even were they
strong as lions, yea, as the strongest and fiercest of them. Broken -
Which is true literally; the lions when taken having most commonly their
teeth broken, as ancient and modern writers relate. But this is meant of
powerful tyrants, who are fitly compared to lions, <scripRef passage="Ezek xxxii. 2" id="ii.xix.v.ii-p7.1" parsed="|Ezek|32|2|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Ezek.32.2">Ezek
xxxii, 2</scripRef>; xxxviii, 13, who though for a time they persecute and
oppress other men, yet in due time they are restrained, and broken, and
crushed in pieces by the mighty power of God. Possibly he may secretly
accuse Job, or his children, that being persons of great wealth and
power, they had abused it to ruin their neighbours, and therefore were
justly cut off.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p8">11. Scattered - Gone from their dens several ways to hunt
for prey, and can find none.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p9">12. Now - To convince Job of the sin and folly of
impatience, Eliphaz relates a vision he had had, perhaps since he came
to him. Which in that age and state of the church, before the holy
scriptures were written, was the usual way of God's discovering his mind
to those that sought him. A thing - Hebrew. a word, from God, a message.
Secretly - Hebrew. was stolen, or brought by stealth unto me, privately
and secretly, as the word of God used to come to the prophets, being
spoken in their ear, as it was to Samuel, with a low and still voice. He
does not pretend to have understood it fully; but something of it he
perceived. How little a portion is heard of God! How little do we know
of him in this world.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p10">13. In thoughts - These thoughts arose from the visions
of the night, which it is probable he had seen before. Visions differed
from dreams herein, that God imparted his mind to men in dreams when
asleep, but in visions, when they were awake. And these visions
sometimes happened by day, but most frequently by night. Sleep - In the
dead of the night, when men usually are in a deep sleep; though Eliphaz
was not now asleep.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p11">15. A spirit - An angel in visible shape, otherwise he
could not have discerned it. Stood up - Through that excessive horror
caused by so glorious, unusual, and terrible a presence.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p12">16. Stood - Having passed by him to, and again, he made a
stand, and addressed himself to speak. The form - Exactly and
distinctly. An image - I saw some visible resemblance, though in a
confused manner. Silence - The spirit, which possibly had made some
noise with his motion, now standing still made no noise; all other
persons and things about me were silent, and I also kept in my voice and
breath, that I might distinctly hear. In the Hebrew, the words run thus,
silence and a voice I heard.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p13">17. More just - Pretend more strictly to observe the laws
of justice? Shall (enosh) mortal, miserable man (so the word signifies)
be thus insolent? Nay, shall geber, the strongest and most eminent man,
stand in competition with God? Those that find fault with the directions
of the Divine law, the dispensations of the Divine grace, or the
disposal of the Divine providence, do make themselves more just and pure
than God: who being their maker, is their Lord and owner: and the author
of all the justice and purity that is in man.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p14">18. Servants - They are called his servants by way of
eminency, that general name being here appropriated to the chief of the
kind, to intimate that sovereign dominion which the great God hath over
the angels, and much more over men. With folly - Without all doubt, this
refers to those angels who foolishly and wickedly fell from God.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p15">19. How, &amp;c. - The sense is, what strange presumption
then is it for a foolish and mortal man, to make himself more just than
God. In them - Who though they have immortal spirits, yet those spirits
dwell in mortal bodies, which are great clogs, and incumbrances, and
snares to them. These are called houses, (because they are the
receptacles of the soul, and the places of its settled abode) and houses
of clay, because they were made of clay, or earth, and to note their
great frailty and mutability; whereas the angels are free spirits,
unconfined to such carcasses, and dwell in celestial, and glorious, and
everlasting mansions. Whose - Whose very foundation, no less than the
rest of the building, is in the dust; had their original from it, and
must return to it. We stand but upon the dust: some have an higher heap
of dust to stand upon than others. But still it is the earth that stays
us up, and will shortly swallow us up. Before - Sooner than a moth is
crushed, which is easily done by a gentle touch of the finger. Or, at
the face of a moth. No creature is so contemptible, but one time or
other it may have the body of man in its power.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p16">20. Destroyed - All the day long, there is not a moment
wherein man is not sinking towards death and corruption. Perish - In
reference to this present worldly life, which when once lost is never
recovered. Regarding - Hebrew. without putting the heart to it, this is
so common a thing for all men, though never so high and great, to perish
in this manner, that no man heeds it, but passes it by as a general
accident not worthy of observation.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.v.ii-p17">21. Excellency - Whatsoever is by common estimation
excellent in men, all their natural, and moral, and civil
accomplishments, as high birth, great riches, power and wisdom, these
are so far from preserving men from perishing, that they perish
themselves, together with those houses of clay in which they are lodged.
Without wisdom - Even without having attained that only wisdom for which
they came into the world. Shall such mean, weak, foolish, sinful, dying
creatures as this, pretend to be more just than God, more pure than his
maker? No: instead of quarrelling with his afflictions, let him admire
that he is out of hell.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="V" progress="72.86%" prev="ii.xix.v.ii" next="ii.xix.vi.i" id="ii.xix.vi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job V" id="ii.xix.vi-p0.1" parsed="|Job|5|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.5" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.vi-p0.2">V</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter V" progress="72.86%" prev="ii.xix.vi" next="ii.xix.vi.ii" id="ii.xix.vi.i">

<p id="ii.xix.vi.i-p1">Sin occasions destruction, ver. 1-5. Affliction is the
common lot of mankind, ver. 6-7. In affliction we should fly to God, who
is both able and willing to help, ver. 8-16. He will deliver them that
trust in him, ver. 17-27.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter V" progress="72.86%" prev="ii.xix.vi.i" next="ii.xix.vii" id="ii.xix.vi.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p1">1. Call - Call them all as it were by their names: will
not every good man confirm what I say? If - Try if there be any one
saint that will defend thee in these bold expostulations with God. Thou
mayst find fools or wicked men, to do it: but not one of the children of
God.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p2">2. Killeth - A man's wrath, and impatience, preys upon
his spirit, and so hastens his death; and provokes God to cut him off.
The foolish - The rash and inconsiderate man, who does not weigh things
impartially. Envy, &amp;c. - I perceive thou art full of envy at wicked
men, who seem to be in a happier condition than thou, and of wrath
against God; and this shews thee to be a foolish and weak man. For those
men, notwithstanding their present prosperity, are doomed to great and
certain misery. I have myself seen the proof of this.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p3">3. Foolish - The wicked man. Root - Not only prosperous
for the present, but, as it seemed, firm and secure for the future.
Suddenly - In a moment, beyond mine, and his own, and all other mens
expectation. Cursed - l saw by the event which followed his prosperity,
that he was a man accursed of God.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p4">4. Children - Whose greatness he designed in all his
enterprizes, supposing his family would be established forever. Safely
- Are exposed to dangers and calamities, and can neither preserve
themselves, nor the inheritance which their fathers left them. There is
no question but he glances here, at the death of Job's children.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p5">5. Harvest - Which they confidently expect to reap after
all their cost and labour, but are sadly and suddenly disappointed. The
hungry - The hungry Sabeans eat it up. Thorns - Out of the fields: in
spite of all dangers or difficulties in their way.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p6">6. The dust - It springs not up by merely natural causes,
as herbs grow out of the earth: but from God. Eliphaz here begins to
change his voice, as if he would atone for the hard words he had
spoken.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p7">7. Is born - He is so commonly exposed to various
troubles, as if he were born to no other end: affliction is become
natural to man, and is transmitted from parents, to children, as their
constant inheritance; God having allotted this portion to mankind for
their sins. And therefore thou takest a wrong course in complaining so
bitterly of that which thou shouldest patiently bear, as the common lot
of mankind. As - As naturally, and as generally, as the sparks of fire
fly upward. Why then should we be surprized at our afflictions as
strange, or quarrel with them, as hard?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p8">8. I would - If I were in thy condition. Seek - By
prayer, and humiliation, and submission, imploring his pardon, and
favour.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p9">9. Who, &amp;c. - Here Eliphaz enters upon a discourse of
the infinite perfection of God's nature and works; which he doth as an
argument to enforce the exhortation to seek and commit his cause to God,
ver. 8, because God was infinitely able either to punish him yet far
worse, if he continued to provoke him; or to raise him from the dust, if
he humbly addressed himself to him: and that by a representation of
God's excellency and glory, and of that vast disproportion which was
between God and Job, he might convince Job of his great sin in speaking
so boldly and irreverently of him. marvelous - Which (though common, and
therefore neglected and despised, yet) are matter of wonder to the
wisest men. The works of nature are mysteries: the most curious searches
come far short of full discoveries: and the works of Providence are
still more deep and unaccountable.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p10">10. Rain - He begins with this ordinary work of God, in
which he implies that there is something wonderful, as indeed there is
in the rise of it from the earth, in the strange hanging of that heavy
body in the air, and in the distribution of it as God sees fit; and how
much more in the hidden paths of Divine Providence?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p11">11. To set up - That is, he setteth up. Another example
of God's great and wonderful works. He gives this instance to comfort
and encourage Job to seek to God, because he can raise him out of his
greatest depths.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p12">13. The wise - Men wise to do evil, and wise in the
opinion of the world, he not only deceives in their hopes and counsels,
but turns them against themselves. Froward - Or, wrestlers: such as wind
and turn every way, as wrestlers do, and will leave no means untried to
accomplish their counsels. Is carried - Is tumbled down and broken, and
that by their own precipitation.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p13">14. Meet - In plain things they run into gross mistakes,
and chuse those courses which are worst for themselves. Darkness often
notes misery, but here ignorance or error. Grope - Like blind men to
find their way, not knowing what to do.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p14">15. Mouth - Which was ready to swallow them up.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p15">16. So - So he obtains what he hoped for from God, to
whom he committed his cause. Iniquity - Wicked men. Stoppeth - They are
silenced and confounded, finding that not only the poor are got out of
their snares, but the oppressors themselves are ensnared in them.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p16">17. Behold - Eliphaz concludes his discourse, with giving
Job a comfortable hope, if he humbled himself before God. Happy -
Hebrew. Blessednesses (various and great happiness) belong to that man
whom God rebukes. The reason is plain, because afflictions are pledges
of God's love, which no man can buy too dear; and are necessary to purge
out sin, and thereby to prevent infinite and eternal miseries. Without
respect to this, the proposition could not be true. And therefore it
plainly shews, that good men in those ancient times, had the belief, and
hope of everlasting blessedness. Despise not - Do not abhor it as a
thing pernicious, refuse it as a thing useless, or slight it as an
unnecessary thing. But more is designed than is exprest. Reverence the
chastening of the Lord: have an humble, aweful regard to his correcting
hand, and study to answer the design of it. The Almighty - Who is able
to support and comfort thee in thy troubles, and deliver thee out of
them: and also to add more calamities to them, if thou art obstinate and
incorrigible.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p17">18. For he, &amp;c. - God's usual method is, first to
humble, and then to exalt. And he never makes a wound too great, too
deep for his own cure.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p18">19. Deliver - If thou seekest to him by prayer and
repentance. Here he applies himself to Job directly. Six - Manifold and
repeated. Touch - So as to destroy thee. Thou shalt have a good issue
out of all thy troubles, though they are both great and many.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p19">20. He shall - These things he utters with more
confidence, because the rewards or punishments of this life, were more
constantly distributed to men in the Old Testament according to their
good or bad behaviour, than they are now: and because it was his
opinion, that great afflictions were the certain evidences of
wickedness; and consequently, that great deliverances would infallibly
follow upon true repentance.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p20">22. Laugh - With a laughter of joy and triumph, arising
from a just security and confidence in God's watchful and gracious
providence.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p21">23. League - Thou shalt be free from annoyance thereby,
as if they had made an inviolable league with thee. This is a bold
metaphor, but such as are frequent both in scripture and other authors.
This is an addition to the former privilege; they shall not hurt thee,
ver. 22, nay, they shall befriend thee, as being at peace with thee. Our
covenant with God is a covenant with all the creatures, that they shall
do us no hurt, but serve and be ready to do us good.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p22">24. Know - By certain experience.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p23">25. Know - By assurance from God's promises, and the
impressions of his Spirit; and by experience in due time.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p24">26. Full age - In a mature and old, but vigourous age, as
the word implies. It is a great blessing, to live to a full age, and not
to have the number of our years cut short. Much more, to be willing to
die, to come cheerfully to the grave: and to die seasonably, just in the
bed-time, when our souls are ripe for God.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vi.ii-p25">27. Searched - This is no rash or hasty conceit, but what
both I and my brethren have learned by deep consideration, long
experience, and diligent observation. Know thou - Know it for thyself;
(So the word is) with application to thy own case. That which we thus
hear and know for ourselves, we hear and know for our good.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VI" progress="73.01%" prev="ii.xix.vi.ii" next="ii.xix.vii.i" id="ii.xix.vii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job VI" id="ii.xix.vii-p0.1" parsed="|Job|6|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.6" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.vii-p0.2">VI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VI" progress="73.01%" prev="ii.xix.vii" next="ii.xix.vii.ii" id="ii.xix.vii.i">

<p id="ii.xix.vii.i-p1">Job shews that he has reason to complain, ver. 1-7. He
compassionately wishes for death, ver. 8-13. Reproves his friends for
their uncharitable censures, ver. 14-30.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VI" progress="73.01%" prev="ii.xix.vii.i" next="ii.xix.viii" id="ii.xix.vii.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p1">2. My grief - The cause of my grief. Weighed - Were fully
understood, and duly considered. O that I had an equal judge! that would
understand my case, and consider whether I have not cause for
complaints. Together - Together with any other most heavy thing to be
put into the other scale.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p2">3. Sea - Which is heavier than dry sand. Swallowed - My
voice and spirit fail me. I cannot find, or utter words sufficient to
express my sorrow or misery.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p3">4. Arrows - So he fitly calls his afflictions, because,
like arrows, they came upon him swiftly and suddenly one after another,
immediately shot by God into his spirit. Poison - Implying that these
arrows were more keen than ordinary, being dipped in God's wrath, as the
barbarous nations used to dip their arrows in poison, that they might
not only pierce, but burn up and consume the vital parts. Drinketh -
Exhausteth and consumeth my soul. In array - They are like a numerous
army, who invade me on every side. This was the sorest part of his
calamity, wherein he was an eminent type of Christ, who complained most
of the sufferings of his soul. Now is my soul troubled. My soul is
exceeding sorrowful. My God, my God, why hast thou forsaken me? Indeed
trouble of mind is the sorest trouble. A wounded spirit who can
bear.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p4">5. Doth, &amp;c. - Even the brute beasts, when they have
convenient food, are quiet and contented. So it is no wonder that you
complain not, who live in ease and prosperity, any more than I did, when
I wanted nothing.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p5">6. Can, &amp;c. - Do men use to eat unsavoury meats with
delight, or without complaint? Men commonly complain of their meat when
it is but unsavoury, how much more when it is so bitter as mine is?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p6">7. The things, &amp;c. - The sense may be, those grievous
afflictions, which I dreaded the very thought of, are now my daily,
though sorrowful bread.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p7">9. Destroy - To end my days and calamities together.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p8">10. Harden - I would bear up with courage under all my
torments, with the hopes of death, and blessedness after death. Spare -
Not suffer me to live any longer. Concealed - As I have steadfastly
believed them, and not wilfully departed from them, so I have not been
ashamed, nor afraid, boldly to profess and preach the true religion in
the midst of Heathens. And therefore I know if God doth cut me off, I
shall be a gainer by it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p9">11. Strength - My strength is so spent, that it is vain
for me to hope for such restitution as thou hast promised me, chap. v,
22. End - What is death to me? It is not terrible, but comfortable. That
- Then why should I desire to prolong my life. But as desirous of death
as Job was, yet he never offered to put an end to his own life. Such a
thought will never be entertained by any, that have the least regard to
the law of God and nature. How uneasy soever the soul's confinement in
the body may be, it must by no means break the prison, but wait for a
fair discharge.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p10">12. Is, &amp;c. - I am not made of stone or brass, but of
flesh and blood, as others are, therefore I am unable to endure these
miseries longer, and can neither hope for. nor desire the continuance of
my life.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p11">13. What, &amp;c. - If my outward condition be helpless
and hopeless? Have I therefore lost my understanding, cannot I judge
whether it is more desirable for me to live or to die, whether I be an
hypocrite or no, whether your words have truth and weight in them;
whether you take the right method in dealing with me?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p12">14. To him - Hebrew. to him that is melted or dissolved
with affections. But. &amp;c. - But thou hast no pity for thy friend; a
plain evidence that thou art guilty of what thou didst charge me with,
even of the want of the fear of God. The least which those that are at
ease can do for them that are pained, is to pity them, to feel a tender
concern for them, and to sympathize with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p13">15. Brethren - Friends; for though Eliphaz only had
spoken, the other two shewed their approbation of his discourse.
Deceitfully - Adding to the afflictions which they said they came to
remove. And it is no new thing, for even brethren to deal deceitfully.
It is therefore our wisdom to cease from man. We cannot expect too
little from the creature, or too much from the creator.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p14">16. Which - Which in winter when the traveler neither
needs nor desires it, are full of water congealed by the frost. Snow -
Under which the water from snow, which formerly fell, and afterward was
dissolved, lies hid. So he speaks not of those brooks which are fed by a
constant spring, but of them which are filled by accidental falls of
water or snow.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p15">17. Warm - When the weather grows milder. Hot - In the
hot season, when waters are most refreshing and necessary.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p16">18. Perish - They are gone out of their channel, flowing
hither and thither, 'till they are quite consumed.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p17">19. Tema - This place and Sheba were both parts of the
hot and dry country of Arabia, in which waters were very scarce, and
therefore precious and desirable, especially to travelers. Companies -
Men did not there travel singly, as we do, but in companies for their
security against wild beasts and robbers.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p18">20. Hoped - They comforted themselves with the
expectation of water. Ashamed - As having deceived themselves and
others. We prepare confusion for ourselves, by our vain hopes: the reeds
break under us, because we lean upon them.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p19">21. Nothing - You are to me as if you had never come to
me; for I have no comfort from you. Afraid - You are shy of me, and
afraid for yourselves, lest some further plagues should come upon me,
wherein you for my sake, should be involved: or, lest I should be
burdensome to you.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p20">22. Did I say - Give me something for my support or
relief. You might have at least given me comfortable words, when I
expected nothing else from you.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p21">23. Deliver - By the force of your arms, as Abraham
delivered Lot. Redeem - By price or ransom.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p22">24. Teach - Convince me by solid arguments. I will - I
will patiently hear and gladly receive your counsels.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p23">25. Forcible - The words of truth have a marvelous power.
Reprove - But there is no truth in your assertions or weight in your
arguments.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p24">26. Words - Do you think it is sufficient to quarrel with
some of my words, without giving allowance for human infirmity, or
extreme misery. Desperate - Of a poor miserable, hopeless and helpless
man. As wind - Which pass away and are forgotten.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p25">27. Overwhelm - You load with censures and calumnies.
Desolate - Me who am deprived of all my children, my estate, and my
friends. I spoke all I thought, as to my friends, and you thence
occasion to cast me down.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p26">28. Look - Consider my cause better than you have done,
that you may give a more righteous judgment. Evident - You will plainly
discover it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p27">29. Return - Turn from your former judgment. Iniquity -
Or, there shall be no iniquity, in my words. Righteousness - In this
cause or matter between you and me; and you will find the right to be on
my side.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.vii.ii-p28">30. Is there - Consider if there be any untruth or
iniquity in what I have already said, or shall farther speak. Taste - My
judgment, which judgeth of words and actions, as the palate doth of
meats.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VII" progress="73.13%" prev="ii.xix.vii.ii" next="ii.xix.viii.i" id="ii.xix.viii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job VII" id="ii.xix.viii-p0.1" parsed="|Job|7|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.7" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.viii-p0.2">VII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VII" progress="73.13%" prev="ii.xix.viii" next="ii.xix.viii.ii" id="ii.xix.viii.i">

<p id="ii.xix.viii.i-p1">Job bemoans himself to his friends, ver. 1-6. To God,
ver. 7- 16. Begs for pardon and death, ver. 17-21.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VII" progress="73.14%" prev="ii.xix.viii.i" next="ii.xix.ix" id="ii.xix.viii.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p1">1. Is there not - Job is here excusing what he cannot
justify, his passionate longing for death. A time - Is there not a time
limited by God, wherein man shall live in this sinful, and miserable
world? And is it a crime in me, to desire that God would bring me to
that joyful period? Our time on earth is limited and short, according to
the narrow bounds of this earth. But heaven cannot be measured, nor the
days of heaven numbered. Hireling - Whose time is short, being but a few
years, or days, whose condition is full of toil and hardship.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p2">2. Shadow - That is, the sun-set, the time allotted for
his rest.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p3">3. So - This so respects not so much the desire of an
hired servant, as the ground of it, his hard toil and service. Possess -
God, hath given me this as my lot and inheritance. Months - So he calls
them rather than days, to note the tediousness of his affliction. Vanity
- Empty and unsatisfying. Nights - He mentions nights, because that is
the saddest time for sick and miserable persons; the darkness and
solitude of the night being of themselves uncomfortable, and giving them
more opportunity for solemn and sorrowful reflections.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p4">5. Worms - Which were bred out of Job's corrupted flesh
and sores. Dust - The dust of the earth upon which he lay. Broken - By
ulcers in all parts of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p5">6. Swifter - The time of my life hastens to a period.
Shuttle - Which passes in a moment from one end of the web to the other.
Hope - Of enjoying any good day here.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p6">7. O - He turns his speech to God. Perhaps observing,
that his friends grew weary of hearing it. If men will not hear us, God
will: if men cannot help us, he can: for his arm is not shortened,
neither is his ear heavy.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p7">8. No more - In this mortal state: I shall never return
to this life again. Am not - If thou cast one angry look upon me, I am
not; thou canst look me into eternity.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p8">9. No more - Never until the general resurrection. When
we see a cloud which looked great, as if it would eclipse the sun, of a
sudden dispersed and disappearing, say, Just such a thing is the life of
man, a vapor that appears for a while and then vanisheth away.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p9">10. Any more - He shall no more be seen and known in his
former habitation. It concerns us to secure a better place when we die:
for this will own us no more.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p10">11. Therefore - Since my life is so vain and short, and
when once lost, without all hopes of recovery. I will plead with God for
pity before I die; I will not smother my anguish within my breast, but
will ease myself by pouring out my complaints.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p11">12. A sea - Am I as fierce and unruly as the sea, which,
if thou didst not set bounds to it, would overwhelm the earth? Or, am I
a vast and ungovernable sea-monster? Which thou must restrain by thy
powerful providence. That, &amp;c. - That thou shouldest guard and
restrain me with such heavy and unexampled miseries? We are apt in
affliction to complain of God, as if he laid more upon us than there is
occasion for: whereas we are never in heaviness, but when there is need,
nor more than there is need.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p12">17. What, &amp;c. - What is there in that poor, mean,
creature called man, miserable man, as this word signifies, which can
induce thee to take any notice of him, or to make such account of him?
Man is not worthy of thy favour, and he is below thy anger; that thou
shouldest concern thyself so much about him, as one near and dear to
thee?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p13">18. And try, &amp;c. - What is man that vain, foolish
creature, that thou shouldest magnify or regard, or visit him, (with thy
mercy and blessings, that thou shouldest so far honour and regard him,
as by thy visitation to preserve his spirit, or hold his soul in life)
and try him, which God doth not only by afflictions, but also by
prosperity and both inward and outward blessings? That thou shouldst
observe his motions every moment, as in care for him, and jealous over
him?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p14">19. How long - How long will it be ere thou withdraw thy
afflicting hand? Swallow - That I may have a breathing time: a
proverbial expression.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p15">20. Sinned - Although I am free from those crying sins,
for which my friends suppose thou hast sent this judgment upon me, yet,
I freely confess I am a sinner, and therefore obnoxious to thy justice.
What, &amp;c. - To satisfy thy justice, or regain thy favour? Who dost
know and diligently observe all mens inward motions, and outward
actions; and therefore, if thou shalt be severe to mark mine iniquities,
I have not what to say or do unto thee. My case is singular, none is
shot at as I am.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.viii.ii-p16">21. Pardon - Seeing thou art so gracious to others, why
may not I hope for the same favour from thee? Dust - If thou dost not
speedily help me, it will be too late. But I shall not be - It will be
to late to shew me favour.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="VIII" progress="73.22%" prev="ii.xix.viii.ii" next="ii.xix.ix.i" id="ii.xix.ix">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job VIII" id="ii.xix.ix-p0.1" parsed="|Job|8|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.8" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.ix-p0.2">VIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter VIII" progress="73.22%" prev="ii.xix.ix" next="ii.xix.ix.ii" id="ii.xix.ix.i">

<p id="ii.xix.ix.i-p1">Bildad affirms, that Job had spoken amiss, ver. 1-3. That
if he would sincerely seek to God, God would help him, ver. 4-7. That it
is usual with God, to destroy the hypocrite, ver. 8-19. The joy of the
upright, ver. 20-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter VIII" progress="73.22%" prev="ii.xix.ix.i" next="ii.xix.x" id="ii.xix.ix.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p1">2. Strong wind - Boisterous and violent.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p2">3. Doth God - Hebrew. The might God, as this word
signifies, the Almighty, or All-sufficient God, as the next name of God
implies. These names are emphatically used, to prove that God cannot
deal unjustly or falsely with men, because he hath no need of it, nor
temptation to it, being self-sufficient for his own happiness, and being
able by his own invincible power to do whatsoever pleaseth him. Pervert
- Judge unrighteously? No, this is inconsistent with God's nature, and
with his office of governor of the world.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p3">4. If - If thou wast innocent, thy children, upon whom a
great part of these calamities fell, might be guilty; and therefore God
is not unrighteous in these proceedings.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p4">5. Betimes - Hebrew. rise early to seek him, if thou
wouldest seek him speedily, early and diligently.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p5">6. Habitation - The concerns of thy house and family;
which thou hast got and managed with righteousness.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p6">8. Search - Seriously and industriously search the
ancient records.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p7">9. We, &amp;c. - But lately born, and therefore have but
little knowledge and experience. We live not so long as they did, to
make observations on the methods of Divine Providence.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p8">10. Utter - Not partially, but sincerely, speaking their
inward thoughts; not rashly, but from deep consideration; not by
hearsay, but their own knowledge.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p9">11. Can, &amp;c. - The hypocrite cannot build his hope,
without some false, rotten ground or other, any more than the rush can
grow without mire, or the flag without water.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p10">12. Greenness - Whereby it promises long continuance.
Tho' no man cut it down, it withers of itself, sooner than other
herbs.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p11">13. Paths - Of wicked men. By their paths he doth not
understand their manner of living, but the events which befall them,
God's manner of dealing with them.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p12">14. Hope - Whose wealth and outward glory, the matter of
his hope, and trust, shall be cut off suddenly and violently taken away
from him. Web - Which tho' it be formed with great art and industry, is
easily swept down, or pulled in pieces.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p13">15. House - He shall trust to the multitude of his
children and servants, and to his wealth, all which come under the name
of a man's house in scripture. Hold it - To uphold himself by it. But
his web, that refuge of lies, will be swept away, and he crushed in
it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p14">16. He - The secure and prosperous sinner may think
himself wronged, when he is compared to a rush or flag. Compare him then
to a flourishing and well-rooted tree. Yet even then shall he be
suddenly cut off. Green - Flourisheth in the world. Before the sun -
Publickly and in the view of all men. Branch - His children, who are
here mentioned as additions not only to his comfort, but also to his
strength and safety. Garden - A place where it is defended from those
injuries to which the trees of the field are subject, and where, besides
the advantages common to all trees, it hath peculiar helps from the art
and industry of men. So he supposes this man to be placed in the most
desirable circumstances.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p15">17. Heap - Of stones. This circumstance is added, to
signify its firmness and strength, that it was not in loose and sandy
ground, which a violent wind might overthrow, but in solid ground,
within which were many stones, which its numerous and spreading roots
embrace, folding and interweaving themselves about them. Seeth - The
tree reacheth thither, takes the advantage of that place for the
strengthening of itself.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p16">18. He - God, who is the saviour of good men, and the
destroyer of the wicked. It - The place; to which denying him, and
seeing him, are here ascribed figuratively. Not seen - He shall be so
utterly extirpated and destroyed, that there shall be no memorial of him
left.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p17">19. Behold - This is the issue of the flourishing state.
This all his joy comes to. And, &amp;c. - Out of the same earth or place
shall another tree grow.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p18">20. Behold - God who will not help the evildoer, will not
cast away a good man, tho he may be cast down. Yet it may be, he will
not be lifted up in this world: and therefore Bildad could not infer,
that if Job was not restored to temporal prosperity, he was not a good
man. Let us judge nothing before the time, but wait 'till the secrets of
all hearts are revealed, and the present difficulties of providence
solved, to universal and everlasting satisfaction.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.ix.ii-p19">21. 'Till, &amp;c. - And what I have said in general of
good men, shall be made good to thee, if thou art such: God will not
forsake thee, nor desist from doing thee good, 'till he give thee
abundant matter of rejoicing.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="IX" progress="73.30%" prev="ii.xix.ix.ii" next="ii.xix.x.i" id="ii.xix.x">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job IX" id="ii.xix.x-p0.1" parsed="|Job|9|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.9" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.x-p0.2">IX</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter IX" progress="73.30%" prev="ii.xix.x" next="ii.xix.x.ii" id="ii.xix.x.i">

<p id="ii.xix.x.i-p1">God's justice, wisdom, power and sovereignty, ver. 1-13.
Job condemns himself, as not able to contend with God, ver. 14-21. Shews
that we cannot judge men by their outward condition, ver. 22-24. And
complains of the greatness of his troubles, and the loss he was at, what
to say or do, ver. 25-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter IX" progress="73.31%" prev="ii.xix.x.i" next="ii.xix.xi" id="ii.xix.x.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p1">2. I know - That God is just in all his ways, that he
doth ordinarily bless the righteous, and punish the wicked. Before God -
And I know that no man is absolutely just, if God be severe to mark what
is amiss in him.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p2">3. One - One accusation among a thousand which God shall
produce against him.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p3">4. He - He is infinitely wise, and searcheth all mens
hearts and ways, and discovers a multitude of sins which mens short
sighted- eyes cannot see; and therefore can charge them with innumerable
evils, where they thought themselves innocent, and sees far more
malignity than men could discern in their sins. Mighty - So that whether
men contend with God by wisdom or by strength: God will be conqueror.
Hardened himself - Obstinately contended with him. The devil promised
himself that Job in the day of his affliction, would curse and speak ill
of God. But instead of that, he sets himself to honour God, and speak
highly of him. As ill pained as he is, and as much as he is taken up
with his own miseries, when he has occasion to mention the wisdom and
power of God, he forgets his complaints and expatiates with a flood of
eloquence on that glorious subject.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p4">5. Who - He proceeds to give evidence of the Divine power
and wisdom. Removeth - Suddenly and unexpectedly. They - The mountains,
to which he ascribes sense and knowledge figuratively. In anger - In
token of his displeasure with the men that live upon them.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p5">6. The earth - Great portions of it, by earthquakes, or
by removing islands. Pillars - The deep and inward parts of it, which
like pillars supported those parts that appear to our view.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p6">8. Who. &amp;c. - A farther description of a black and
tempestuous season, wherein the heavens seem to be brought down nearer
to the earth. Treadeth - Represseth and ruleth them when they rage and
are tempestuous: for treading upon any thing, signifies in scripture
using power and dominion over it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p7">9. Ordereth - Disposeth them, governeth their rising and
setting, and all their influences. These he names as constellations of
greatest eminency; but under them he seems to comprehend all the stars,
which as they were created by God, so are under his government. Arcturus
is a northern constellation, near that called the Bear. Orion is a more
southerly constellation, that rises to us in December. The Pleiades is a
constellation not far from Orion, which we call the seven stars: by the
chambers, (or inmost chambers, as the word signifies) of the south, he
seems to understand those stars and constellations which are toward the
southern pole, which are called inward chambers, because they are for
the most part hid and shut up from these parts of the world.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p8">10. Doth great things, &amp;c. - Job here says the same
that Eliphaz had said, chap. v, 9, and in the original, in the very same
words, with design to shew his full agreement with him, touching the
Divine perfections.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p9">11. Goeth - He works by his providence in ways of mercy
or judgment. Passeth - He goeth from place to place: from one action to
another: he speaks of God after the manner of men.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p10">12. Taketh - If he determines to take away from any man
his children or servants, or estate, who is able to restrain him from
doing it? Or who dare presume to reprove him for it? And therefore far
be it from me to quarrel with God, whereof you untruly accuse me.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p11">13. Helpers - Those who undertake to uphold and defend
one another against him. Stoop - Fall and are crushed by him.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p12">14. How shall I - Since no creature can resist his power,
and no man can comprehend his counsels and ways; how can I contend with
him? Answer his allegations and arguments, produced against me.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p13">15. Tho' - Though I were not conscious to myself of any
sin. Would not - I durst not undertake to plead my cause against him; or
maintain my integrity before him, because he knows me better than I know
myself. Supplication - That he would judge favourably of me and my
cause, and not according to the rigor of his justice.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p14">16. Yet - I could not believe that God had indeed granted
my desire, because I am still full of the tokens of his displeasure; and
therefore should conclude that it was but a pleasant dream, and not a
real thing.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p15">17. Breaketh - Unexpectedly, violently, and
irrecoverably. Cause - Not simply without any desert of his, but without
any special cause of such singular afflictions; and peculiar and
extraordinary guilt, such as his friends charged him with.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p16">18. Breath - My pains are continual, and I have not so
much as a breathing time free from them.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p17">19. If - If my cause were to be decided by power. Is
Strong - Stronger than I. Judgment - If I would contend with him in a
way of right. Who - There is no superior judge that can summon him and
me together.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p18">20. Justify - If I plead against God mine own
righteousness and innocency.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p19">21. Perfect - If I should think myself perfect, yet I
would not know, not acknowledge, my soul; I could not own nor plead
before God the integrity of my soul, but would only make supplication to
my judge, I would abhor, or condemn my life, I would not trust to the
integrity either of my soul and heart, or of my life, so as to justify
myself before the pure and piercing eyes of the all-seeing God.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p20">22. This - In the other things which you have spoken of
God's greatness, and justice, I do not contend with you, but this one
thing I do, and must affirm against you. He - God sends afflictions
promiscuously upon good and bad men.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p21">23. Suddenly - If some common judgment come upon a
people. Laugh - God will be well pleased, to see how the same scourge,
which is the perdition of the wicked, is the trial of the innocent, and
of their faith, which will be found unto praise and honour and
glory.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p22">24. The earth - The dominion over it. Into - Into their
power. As good men are frequently scourged, so the wicked are advanced.
Faces - Meantime he covers the faces of wise and good men, fit to be
Judges, and buries them alive in obscurity, perhaps suffers them to be
condemned, and their faces covered as criminals, by those to whom the
earth is given. This is daily done: if it be not God that doth it, where
and who is he that doth?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p23">25. Now - What he had said of the calamities which God
frequently inflicts upon good men, he now exemplifies in himself. My
days - The days of my life. Post - Who rides upon swift horses. See - I
enjoy no good in them. Seeing is often put for experiencing either good
or evil.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p24">26. Eagle - Which flies swiftly, especially when in the
sight of his prey. See here how swift the motion of time is! It is
always upon the wing, hastening to its period. What little need have we
of past- times! What great need to redeem time, which runs out, runs on
so fast toward eternity! And how vain are the enjoyments of time, which
we may be deprived of, even while time continues! Our day may be longer
than our sunshine: and when that is gone, it is as if it had never
been.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p25">28. Afraid - I find all such endeavours vain; for if my
griefs be suspended for a time, yet my fears continue. Will not - I
plainly perceive thou, O God, (to whom he makes a sudden address, as he

afflictions which make them judge me guilty of some great crime. Words
proceeding from despair and impatience.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p26">29. I shall - I shall be used like a wicked man still.
Why - Why then should I comfort myself with vain hopes of deliverance,
as thou advisest me.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p27">30. If - If I clear myself from all imputations, and
fully prove my innocency before men.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p28">31. Yet - God would prove him to be a most guilty
creature, notwithstanding all his purity before men. Abhor - I shall be
so filthy, that my own clothes, if they had any sense in them, would
abhor to touch me.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p29">32. A man - But one infinitely superior to me in majesty,
and power, and wisdom, and justice. That - That I should presume to
debate my cause with him. Come - Face to face, to plead upon equal
terms.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p30">33. Days-man - Or, umpire. Lay his hand - Order and
govern us in pleading; and oblige us to stand to his decision. Our Lord
Jesus is now the blessed days-man, who has mediated between heaven and
earth, has laid his hand upon us both: to him the father hath committed
all judgment. But this was not made so clear then, as it is now by the
gospel, which leaves no room for such a complaint as this.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p31">34. Fear - The fear and dread of his majesty and justice.
Let him not deal with me according to his perfect justice, but according
to his grace and clemency.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.x.ii-p32">35. Then - I would speak freely for myself, being freed
from that dread, which takes away my spirit and courage. It is not - I
am not free from his terror, and therefore cannot plead my cause with
him.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="X" progress="73.46%" prev="ii.xix.x.ii" next="ii.xix.xi.i" id="ii.xix.xi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job X" id="ii.xix.xi-p0.1" parsed="|Job|10|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.10" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.xi-p0.2">X</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter X" progress="73.46%" prev="ii.xix.xi" next="ii.xix.xi.ii" id="ii.xix.xi.i">

<p id="ii.xix.xi.i-p1">Job complains of the hardships he was under, ver. 1-7.
Pleads with God, that he is his workmanship, ver. 8-13. Complains again,
that God deals severely with him, ver. 14-17. Comforts himself with the
thoughts of death, ver. 18-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter X" progress="73.47%" prev="ii.xix.xi.i" next="ii.xix.xii" id="ii.xix.xi.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p1">1. Shall I - Shall I give over complaining?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p2">2. Condemn - Or, pronounce me not to be a wicked man,
neither deal with me as such, as I confess thou mightest do in rigorous
justice: O discover my integrity by removing this stroke, for which my
friends condemn me. Wherefore - For what ends and reasons, and for what
sins; for I am not conscious to myself of any peculiar sins by which I
have deserved to be made the most miserable of all men. When God
afflicts, he contends with us: when he contends with us, there is always
a reason for it. And it is desirable to know, what that reason is, that
we may forsake whatever he has a controversy with us for.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p3">3. Good - Dost thou take any pleasure in it? Far be it
from Job, to think that God did him wrong. But he is at a loss to
reconcile his providences with his justice. And so other good men have
often been, and will be, until the day shall declare it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p4">4. Eyes of faith - No. Eyes of flesh cannot see in the
dark: but darkness hideth not from God. Eyes of flesh are but in one
place at a time, and can see but a little way. But the eyes of the Lord
are in every place, and run to and fro thro' the whole earth. Eyes of
flesh will shortly be darkened by age, and shut up by death. But the
eyes of God are ever the same, nor does his sight ever decay. As man -
Man sees the outside only, and Judges by appearances: but thou seest
mine heart.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p5">5. Man's - Man's time is short and uncertain, and
therefore he must improve it, and diligently search out the crimes of
malefactors, lest by death he lose the opportunity of doing justice: but
thou art eternal, and seest at one view all mens hearts, and all their
actions present and to come; and therefore thou dost not need to proceed
with me in this manner, by making so long a scrutiny into my heart and
life.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p6">6. Searchest - Keeping me so long upon the rack, to
compel me to accuse myself.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p7">7. Wicked - An hypocrite, as my friends account me.
Deliver - But thou art the supreme ruler of the world; therefore I must
wait thy time, and throw myself on thy mercy, in submission to thy
sovereign will.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p8">9. Clay - As a potter makes a vessel of clay; so this may
note both the frailty of man's nature, which of itself decays and
perishes, and doth not need such violent shocks to overthrow it; and the
excellency of the Divine artifice commended from the meanness of the
materials; which is an argument why God should not destroy it. Again - I
must die by the course of nature, and therefore while I do live, give me
some ease and comfort.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p9">10. As milk - Thus he modestly and accurately describes
God's admirable work in making man out of a small and liquid, and as it
were milky substance, by degrees congealed and condensed into that
exquisite frame of man's body.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p10">11. Clothed - Covered my inward and more noble parts;
which are first formed. So he proceeds in describing man's formation
gradually. Bones - The stay and strength of the body; and some of them,
as the skull and ribs, enclose and defend its vital parts.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p11">12. Life - Thou didst not only give me a curious body,
but also a reasonable soul: thou didst at first give me life, and then
maintain it in me; both when I was in the womb (which is a marvelous
work of God) and afterward when I was unable to do anything to preserve
my own life. favour - Thou didst not give mere life, but many other
favours, such as nourishment by the breast, education, knowledge, and
instruction. Visitation - The care of thy providence watching over me
for my good, and visiting me in mercy. Preserved - My life, which is
liable to manifold dangers, if God did not watch over us every day and
moment. Thou hast hitherto done great things for me, given me life, and
the blessings of life, and daily deliverances: and wilt thou now undo
all that thou hast done? And shall I who have been such an eminent
monument of thy mercy, now be a spectacle of thy vengeance.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p12">13. Hid - Both thy former favours and thy present frowns.
Both are according to thy own will, and therefore undoubtedly
consistent, however they seem. When God does what we cannot account for,
we are bound to believe, there are good reasons for it hid in his heart.
It is not with us, or in our reach to assign the cause; but I know this
is with thee.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p13">14. Markest - If I am a wicked man, I cannot hide it from
thee; and thou wilt punish me for it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p14">15. Wicked - An hypocrite, as my friends esteem me.
Righteous - An upright man; so whether good or bad, all comes to one.
Yet - Yet I have no comfort, or hopes of any good. Confusion - I am
confounded within myself, not knowing what to say or do. Let my
extremity move thee to pity, and help me.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p15">16. Lion - Which hunteth after his prey with great
eagerness, and when he overtakes it, falls upon it with great fury.
Returnest - The lion tears its prey speedily, and so ends its torments;
but thou renewest my calamities again and again, and makest my plagues
wonderful both for kind and extremity, and continuance.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p16">17. Witnesses - Thy judgments, which are the evidences
both of my sins, and of thy wrath. Indignation - My miseries are the
effects of thine anger. Army - Changes may denote the various kinds, and
an army the great number of his afflictions.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xi.ii-p17">20. Cease - My life is short, and of itself hastens to an
end, there is no need that thou shouldest grudge me some ease for so
small a moment.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XI" progress="73.56%" prev="ii.xix.xi.ii" next="ii.xix.xii.i" id="ii.xix.xii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job XI" id="ii.xix.xii-p0.1" parsed="|Job|11|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.11" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.xii-p0.2">XI</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XI" progress="73.56%" prev="ii.xix.xii" next="ii.xix.xii.ii" id="ii.xix.xii.i">

<p id="ii.xix.xii.i-p1">Zophar charges Job with falsehood and pride, ver. 1-4.
Wishes that God would convince him of his wisdom, justice, and
unsearchable perfections, ver. 5-9. Of his sovereignty, power and the
cognisance he takes of men, ver. 10-12. He assures him, that on his
repentance, God would restore him to prosperity, but that the wicked
should perish, ver. 13-20.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XI" progress="73.57%" prev="ii.xix.xii.i" next="ii.xix.xiii" id="ii.xix.xii.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p1">1. Then answered - How hard is it, to preserve calmness,
in the heat of disputation! Eliphaz began modestly: Bildad was a little
rougher: But Zophar falls upon Job without mercy. "Those that have a
mind to fall out with their brethren, and to fall foul upon them, find
it necessary, to put the worst colours they can upon them and their
performances, and right or wrong to make them odious."</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p2">2. Answered - Truly, sometimes it should not. Silence is
the best confutation of impertinence, and puts the greatest contempt
upon it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p3">3. Lies - Both concerning thy own innocency, and
concerning the counsels and ways of God. Mockest - Our friendly and
faithful counsels, chap. vi, 14, 15, 25, 26.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p4">4. Doctrine - Concerning God and his providence. Clean -
I am innocent before God; I have not sinned either by my former actions,
or by my present expressions. But Zophar perverts Job's words, for he
did not deny that he was a sinner, but only that he was an
hypocrite.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p5">5. Speak - Plead with thee according to thy desire: he
would soon put thee to silence. We are commonly ready with great
assurance to interest God in our quarrels. But they are not always in
the right, who are most forward, to appeal to his judgment, and prejudge
it against their antagonists.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p6">6. Secrets - The unsearchable depths of God's wisdom in
dealing with his creatures. Double - That they are far greater (the word
double being used indefinitely for manifold, or plentiful) than that
which is manifested. The secret wisdom of God is infinitely greater than
that which is revealed to us by his word or works: the greatest part of
what is known of God, is the least part of those perfections that are in
him. And therefore thou dost rashly in judging so harshly of his
proceedings with thee, because thou dost not comprehend the reasons of
them, and in judging thyself innocent, because thou dost not see thy
sins; whereas the all- knowing God sees innumerable sins in thee, for
which he may utterly destroy thee.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p7">7. Find out - Discover all the depths of his wisdom, and
the reasons of his actions?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p8">10. Cut off - A person or family. Shut - Its a prison, or
in the hands of an enemy. Gather - Whether it pleaseth God to scatter a
family, or to gather them together from their dispersions. Hinder - Or,
who can contradict him, charge him with injustice in such
proceedings?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p9">11. Knoweth - Though men know but little of God, yet God
knows man exactly. He knoweth that every man in the world is guilty of
much vanity and folly, and therefore seeth sufficient reason for his
severity against the best men. Wickedness - He perceiveth the wickedness
of evil men, though it be covered with the veil of religion. Consider -
Shall he only see it as an idle spectator, and not observe it as a judge
to punish it?</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p10">12. Man - That since the fall is void of all true wisdom,
pretends to be wise, and able to pass a censure upon all God's ways and
works. Colt - Ignorant, and dull, and stupid, as to divine things, and
yet heady and untractable.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p11">13. Heart - To seek God; turning thy bold contentions
with God into humble supplications.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p12">15. Lift up - Which denotes chearfulness, and holy
boldness. Without spot - Having a clear and unspotted conscience.
Steadfast - Shall have a strong and comfortable assurance of God's
favour.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p13">16. As waters - Thou shalt remember it no more, than men
remember a land-flood, which as it comes, so it goes away suddenly.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p14">17. Shine - Light in scripture commonly signifies
prosperity and glory. Thy comfort, like the morning-light shall shine
brighter and brighter, until the perfect day.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p15">18. Secure - Thy mind shall be quiet and free from
terrors, because thou shalt have a firm and well-grounded confidence in
God. Dig - Either to fix thy tents, which after the manner of the
Arabians were removed from place to place: or to plough the ground, as
he had done, chap. i, 14, or to make a fence about thy dwelling.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xii.ii-p16">20. Fail - Either with grief and tears for their sore
calamities: or with long looking for what they shall never attain. Their
hope - They shall never obtain deliverance out of their distresses, but
shall perish in them. Ghost - Shall be as vain and desperate as the hope
of life is in a man, when he is at the very point of death.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XII" progress="73.64%" prev="ii.xix.xii.ii" next="ii.xix.xiii.i" id="ii.xix.xiii">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job XII" id="ii.xix.xiii-p0.1" parsed="|Job|12|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.12" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.xiii-p0.2">XII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XII" progress="73.64%" prev="ii.xix.xiii" next="ii.xix.xiii.ii" id="ii.xix.xiii.i">

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.i-p1">Job blames his friends for their self-conceit and unkind
behaviour, ver. 1-5. Shews that the wicked often prosper, ver. 6- 11.
Confirms and enlarges upon what had been said, of the wisdom, power and
providence of God, ver. 12-25.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XII" progress="73.65%" prev="ii.xix.xiii.i" next="ii.xix.xiv" id="ii.xix.xiii.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p1">2. Ye - You have engrossed all the reason of mankind; and
each of you has as much wisdom as an whole people put together. All the
wisdom which is in the world, lives in you, and will be utterly lost
when you die. When wise and good men die, it is a comfort to think that
wisdom and goodness do not die with them: it is folly to think, that
there will be a great, irreparable loss of us when we are gone, since
God has the residue of the spirit, and can raise up others more fit to
do his work.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p2">3. But - In these things, which he speaks not in a way of
boasting, but for the just vindication both of himself, and of that
cause of God, which for the substance of it he maintained rightly, as
God himself attests, chap. xlii, 7. Such things - The truth is, neither
you nor I have any reason to be puffed up with our knowledge of these
things: for the most barbarous nations know that God is infinite in
wisdom, and power, and justice. But this is not the question between you
and me.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p3">4. Upon God - Even by my religious neighbours, by those
who call upon God, and not in vain; whose prayers therefore I covet, not
their reproaches. The just - I, who, notwithstanding all their hard
censures dare still own it, that through God's grace I am an upright
man.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p4">5. Slip with his feet - And fall into trouble; tho' he
had formerly shone as a lamp, he is then looked upon as a lamp going
out, as the snuff of a candle, which we throw to the ground and tread
upon; and accordingly is despised in the thought of him that is at
ease.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p5">6. Are secure - Job's friends had all supposed, that
wicked men cannot prosper long in the world. This Job opposes, and
maintains, that God herein acts as sovereign, and reserves that exact
distribution of rewards and punishments for the other world.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p6">7. But - If thou observest the beasts, and their
properties and actions, and events, from them thou mayst learn this
lesson: that which Zophar had uttered with so much pomp and gravity,
chap. xi, 7, 8, 9, concerning God's infinite wisdom, saith Job, thou
needest not go into heaven or hell to know. but thou mayst learn it even
from the beasts.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p7">9. Lord - This is the only time that we meet with the
name Jehovah in all the discourses between Job and his friends. For God
in that age was more known by the name of Shaddai, the Almighty.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p8">11. Doth not - This may be a preface to his following
discourse; whereby he invites them to hear and judge of his words
candidly and impartially; that they and he too might agree in
disallowing what should appear to be false, and owning of every
truth.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p9">12. Wisdom - These words contain a concession of what
Bildad had said, chap. viii, 8, 9, and a joining with him in that
appeal; but withal, an intimation that this wisdom was but imperfect,
and liable to many mistakes; and indeed mere ignorance and folly, if
compared with the Divine wisdom, and therefore that antiquity ought not
to be received against the truths of the most wise God.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p10">14. No opening - Without God's permission. Yea, he shuts
up in the grave, and none can break open those sealed doors. He shuts up
in hell, in chains of darkness, and none can pass that great gulf.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p11">15. The waters - Which are reserved its the clouds, that
they may not fall upon the earth. They - The waters upon the earth,
springs, and brooks, and rivers. As at the time of the general deluge,
to which here is a manifest allusion.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p12">16. With him - The same thing he had said before, ver.
13, but he repeats it here to prepare the way for the following events,
which are eminent instances, both of his power and wisdom. Are his -
Wholly subject to his disposal. He governs the deceiver and sets bounds
to his deceits, how far they shall extend; he also over-rules all this
to his own glory, and the accomplishment of his righteous designs of
trying the good, and punishing wicked men, by giving them up to believe
lies. Yet God is not the author of any error or sin, but only the wise
and holy governor of it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p13">17. Spoiled - The wise counsellors or statesmen, by whom
the affairs of kings and kingdoms are ordered, he leadeth away as
captives in triumph, being spoiled either of that wisdom which they had,
or seemed to have; or of that power and dignity which they had enjoyed.
Fools - By discovering their folly, and by infatuating their minds, and
turning their own counsels to their ruin.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p14">18. Looseth - He freeth them from that wherewith they
bind their subjects to obedience, their power and authority, and that
majesty which God stamps upon kings, to keep their people in awe.
Girdeth - He reduces them to a mean and servile condition; which is thus
expressed, because servants did use to gird up their garments (that
after the manner of those parts were loose and long) that they might be
fitter for attendance upon their masters: he not only deposes them from
their thrones, but brings them into slavery.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p15">20. The speech - By taking away or restraining the gift
of utterance from them. Or, by taking away their understanding which
should direct their speech. Trusty - Of those wise and experienced
counsellors, that were trusted by the greatest princes.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p16">22. Darkness - The most secret counsels of princes, which
are contrived and carried on in the dark.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p17">23. Nations - What hitherto he said of princes, he now
applies to nations, whom God does either increase or diminish as he
pleases.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiii.ii-p18">25. Grope - Thus are the revolutions of kingdoms brought
about by an overruling providence. Heaven and earth are shaken: but the
Lord remaineth a king forever.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIII" progress="73.74%" prev="ii.xix.xiii.ii" next="ii.xix.xiv.i" id="ii.xix.xiv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job XIII" id="ii.xix.xiv-p0.1" parsed="|Job|13|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.13" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.xiv-p0.2">XIII</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIII" progress="73.74%" prev="ii.xix.xiv" next="ii.xix.xiv.ii" id="ii.xix.xiv.i">

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.i-p1">Job sharply reproves his friends, ver. 1-13. Professes
his faith, ver. 14-16. Desires to be heard, ver. 17-19. Expostulates
with God, ver. 20-28.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIII" progress="73.75%" prev="ii.xix.xiv.i" next="ii.xix.xv" id="ii.xix.xiv.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p1">1. Lo - All this which either you or I have discoursed
concerning the infinite power and wisdom of God. I know, both by seeing
it, by my own observation and experience, and by hearing it from my
ancestors.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p2">3. Surely - I had rather debate the matter with God than
with you. I am not afraid of presenting my person and cause before him,
who is a witness of my integrity.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p3">8. Accept - Not judging according to the right of the
cause, but the quality or the person.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p4">12. Remembrance - Mouldering and coming to nothing. And
the consideration of our mortality should make us afraid of offending
God. Your mementos are like unto ashes, contemptible and
unprofitable.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p5">14. Wherefore - And this may be a reason of his desire of
liberty of speech, because he could hold his tongue no longer, but must
needs tear himself to pieces, if he had not some vent for his grief. The
phrase having his life in his hand, denotes a condition extremely
dangerous.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p6">17. Hear - He now comes more closely to his business, the
foregoing verses being mostly in way of preface.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p7">18. Behold - I have seriously considered the state of my
case, and am ready to plead my cause.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p8">19. The ghost - My grief would break my heart, if I
should not give it vent.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p9">21. Withdraw - Suspend my torments during the time of my
pleading with thee, that my mind may be at liberty. Do not present
thyself to me in terrible majesty, neither deal with me in rigorous
justice.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p10">22. Then - This proposal savoured of self-confidence, and
of irreverence towards God; for which, and the like speeches, he is
reproved by God, chap. xxxviii, 2, 3; xl, 2.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p11">23. My sin - That I am a sinner, I confess; but not that
I am guilty of such crimes as my friends suppose, if it be so, do thou,
O Lord, discover it.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p12">25. Leaf - One that can no more resist thy power, than a
leaf, or a little dry straw can resist the wind or fire.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p13">26. Writest - Thou appointest or inflictest. A metaphor
from princes or Judges, who anciently used to write their sentences.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xiv.ii-p14">28. He - He speaks of himself in the third person, as is
usual in this and other sacred books. So the sense is, he, this poor
frail creature, this body of mine; which possibly he pointed at with his
finger, consumeth or pineth away.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XIV" progress="73.79%" prev="ii.xix.xiv.ii" next="ii.xix.xv.i" id="ii.xix.xv">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job XIV" id="ii.xix.xv-p0.1" parsed="|Job|14|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.14" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.xv-p0.2">XIV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XIV" progress="73.79%" prev="ii.xix.xv" next="ii.xix.xv.ii" id="ii.xix.xv.i">

<p id="ii.xix.xv.i-p1">Man's life is but short, sorrowful, and sinful; on which
consideration he pleads for mercy, ver, 1-6. Other creatures revive, but
man does not, ver. 7-12. Various wishes and complaints, ver. 13-22.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XIV" progress="73.79%" prev="ii.xix.xv.i" next="ii.xix.xvi" id="ii.xix.xv.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p1">1. Man - A weak creature, and withal corrupt and sinful,
and of that sex by which sin and all other calamity was brought into the
world.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p2">2. Flower - The flower is fading, and all its beauty soon
withers and is gone. The shadow is fleeting, and its very being will
soon be lost in the shadows of night. Of neither do we make any account,
in neither do we put any confidence.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p3">4. Not one - No man. This is the prerogative of thy
grace, which therefore I humbly implore.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p4">5. Determined - Limited to a certain period. With thee -
In thy power and disposal. Thou hast appointed a certain end of his
days, beyond which he cannot prolong his life.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p5">6. Turn - Withdraw thine afflicting hand from him, that
he may have some present ease. 'Till - He come to the period of his
life, which thou hast allotted to him, as a man appoints a set time to
an hired servant.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p6">8. Die - To outward appearance.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p7">9. Scent - By means of water. Scent or smell, is
figuratively ascribed to a tree.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p8">10. Man - Two words are here used for man. Geber, a
mighty man, tho' mighty, dies. Adam, a man of earth, returns to it.
Before death, he is dying daily, continually wasting away. In death, he
giveth up the ghost, the spirit returns to God that gave it. After
death, where is he? Not where he was: his place knows him no more. But
is he nowhere? Yes, he is gone to the world of spirits, gone into
eternity, gone, never to return to this world!</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p9">11. As - So it is with man. Or thus, as when the waters
fail from the sea, when the sea forsakes the place into which it used to
flow, the river which was fed by it, decayeth and drieth up without all
hopes of recovery.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p10">12. Lieth - In his bed, the grave. 'Till - Until the time
of the general resurrection, when these visible heavens shall pass
away.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p11">13. The grave - The grave is not only a resting-place,
but an hiding-place to the children of God. He hides them in the grave,
as we hide our treasure in a place of secrecy and safety. Hide me there,
not only from the storms of this life, but for the glory of a better.
Until thy wrath be past - As long as our bodies lie in the grave, there
are some fruits of God's wrath against sin: until the set time comes,
for their being remembered, as Noah was remembered in the ark, <scripRef passage="Gen. viii. 1" id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p11.1" parsed="|Gen|8|1|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Gen.8.1">Gen. viii, 1</scripRef>. Our bodies shall not be forgotten in the grave, there is a
time set for their being inquired after.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p12">14. Shall he live? - He shall not in this world.
Therefore I will patiently wait 'till that change comes, which will put
a period to my calamities.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p13">15. Answer thee - Thou shalt call my soul to thyself: and
I will cheerfully answer, Here I am: knowing thou wilt have a desire to
the work of thy hands - A love for the soul which thou hast made, and
new-made by thy grace.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p14">16. Numbereth - Thou makest a strict enquiry into all my
actions.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p15">17. Sealed - As writings or other choice things, that
they may all be brought forth upon occasion, and not one of them
forgotten. Thou keepest all my sins in thy memory. But herein Job speaks
rashly.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p16">18. And - As when a great mountain falls, by an
earthquake or inundation, it moulders away like a fading leaf, (as the
Hebrew word signifies) and as the rock, when by the violence of winds or
earthquakes it is removed out of its place, and thrown down, is never
re-advanced: and as the waters by continual droppings, wear away the
stones, so that they can never be made whole again: and as thou wastest
away, by a great and violent inundation, the things which grow out of
the dust of the earth, herbs, and fruits, and plants, which once washed
away are irrecoverably lost; in like manner, thou destroyest the hope of
man: when man dies, all hope of his living again in this world is
lost.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p17">20. Prevailest - When once thou takest away this life, it
is gone forever. Sendest - To his long home.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xv.ii-p18">21. Knoweth not - Either is ignorant of all such events:
or, is not concerned or affected with them. A dead or dying man minds
not these things.</p>
</div4>
</div3>

<div3 title="XV" progress="73.86%" prev="ii.xix.xv.ii" next="ii.xix.xvi.i" id="ii.xix.xvi">
<scripCom type="Commentary" passage="Job XV" id="ii.xix.xvi-p0.1" parsed="|Job|15|0|0|0" osisRef="Bible:Job.15" /> 
<h3 id="ii.xix.xvi-p0.2">XV</h3>

<div4 title="Introduction to Chapter XV" progress="73.86%" prev="ii.xix.xvi" next="ii.xix.xvi.ii" id="ii.xix.xvi.i">

<p id="ii.xix.xvi.i-p1">Eliphaz reproves Job for justifying himself, ver. 1-13.
Persuades him to humble himself before God, ver. 14-16. Describes the
misery of wicked men, ver. 17-35.</p>
</div4>

<div4 title="Commentary on Chapter XV" progress="73.86%" prev="ii.xix.xvi.i" next="ii.xix.xvii" id="ii.xix.xvi.ii">

<p id="ii.xix.xvi.ii-p1">2. Fill - Satisfy his mind and conscience. East wind -
With discourses not only unprofitable, but also pernicious both to
himself and others; as the east-wind was in those parts.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xvi.ii-p2">4. Castest off - Hebrew. thou makes void fear; the fear
of God, piety and religion, by thy unworthy speeches of God, and by
those false and pernicious principles, that God makes no difference
between good and bad in the course of his providence, but equally
prospers or afflicts both: thou dost that which tends to the subversion
of the fear and worship of God. Restrainest prayer - Thou dost by thy
words and principles, as far as in thee lies, banish prayer out of the
world, by making it useless and unprofitable to men.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xvi.ii-p3">5. Uttereth - Thy words discover the naughtiness of thy
heart. Crafty - Thou speakest wickedly, and craftily: thou coverest thy
impious principles with fair pretenses of piety.</p>

<p id="ii.xix.xvi.ii-p4">11. Are - Are those comforts, which we 